Skip to main content

Full text of "A church dictionary : a practical manual of reference for clergymen and students"

See other formats


M-7? 


CORNELL   UNIVERSITY   LIBRARY 


3   1924  079  601    674 


Cornell  University 
Library 


The  original  of  tinis  book  is  in 
tine  Cornell  University  Library. 

There  are  no  known  copyright  restrictions  in 
the  United  States  on  the  use  of  the  text. 


http://www.archive.org/details/cu31924079601674 


In  compliance  with  current 

copyright  law,  Cornell  University 

Library  produced  this 

replacement  volume  on  paper 

that  meets  the  ANSI  Standard 

Z39.48-1992  to  replace  the 

irreparably  deteriorated  original. 

1997 


Sttjara,  Nwn  fork 


CHURCH    DICTIONARY: 

A  PEACTICAL  MANUAL  OF  REFEEENCE  FOR 
CLERGYMEN  AND  STUDENTS. 


By  WALTER  FARQUHAR  HOOK,  D.D., 

LATE  DEAN  OF  CHICHESTER. 


FOURTEENTH  EDITION,  ADAPTED   TO    THE  REQUIREMENTS 
OF  THE  PRESENT  DA  V. 


EDITRD 
By  WALTEE  hook,  M.A.,  Rectoi!  of  RonLOCK, 

AXD 

W.  R.  W.  STEPHENS,  M,A.,  Pkebendaey  of  Ciiiciiestee. 


LONDON: 

JOHN   MURRAY,  ALBEMARLE  STREET. 

1887. 


O   i>  tr     ~> 


'CORr-iEL 


c_ 


T^, 


LONDOK : 

PRINTED  BY  WILLIAM  CLOWES  AND  SONS,  LDlITEn. 

STAMFORD  STBEET  AND  CHARING  CROSS. 


PREFACE  TO  THE  FOURTEENTH  EDITION, 


Dk.  Hook's  "  Church  Dictionaiy  "  is  so  well  and  widely  known,  that 
it  is  scarcely  necessary  now  to  give  a  further  description  of  its  origin 
and  aim  than  by  mentioning  that  it  arose  from  the  great  want  felt  by 
its  author,  in  the  management  of  his  parish,  of  some  book  of  reference 
for  the  laity  as  well  as  for  the  clergy  upon  the  leading  facts  of  the 
history,  the  economy  and  constitution  of  the  Church.  That  Dean 
Hook  was  exceptionally  fitted  for  the  task,  by  his  wide  experience  and 
success  as  a  parish  priest,  by  his  learning,  and  by  his  literary  skill,  has 
been  freely  admitted  on  all  hands. 

Since  the  first  issue  of  the  "  Church  Dictionary,"  in  the  year  1842, 
it  has  passed  through  no  less  than  thirteen  editions,  each  of  which 
underwent  more  or  less  of  improvement  and  addition.  But  of  late 
years  there  has  been  such  a  great  increase  of  activity  in  the  Church, 
and  such  a  vast  extension  of  her  energies  in  every  direction ;  such 
advances  also  have  been  made  in  Biblical  and  Liturgical  criticism,  as 
well  as  in  the  knowledge  of  ecclesiastical  history,  antiquities,  and 
art,  that  it  seemed  desirable  to  submit  the  whole  Dictionary  to  a 
thorough  revision.  This  indeed  was  the  view  taken  by  the  late  Dean, 
who  expressed  to  his  son  an  opinion  that  nearly  the  whole  of  it  ought 
to  be  rewritten  if  it  was  to  be  brought  up  to  the  level  of  modern 
requirements.  The  truth  of  this  has  been  felt  by  the  present  editors 
during  the  progress  of  their  work.  It  has  been  found  necessary,  or 
desirable,  to  rewrite  or  completely  recast  many  of  the  old  articles,  and 
to  add  many  new  ones. 

In  the  first  place,  on  subjects  of  pre-eminent  interest  and  imjportance, 
such  as  the  history  of  the  Bible,  the  Creeds,  the  Liturgy  and  the 
Church  in  its  various  branches,  original  articles  have  been  supplied, 
because  the  old  ones  consisted  largely  of  extracts  from  the  writings  of 
the  older  Divines,  which  in  some  instances  were  rather  antiquated,  and 
might  more  properly  be  called  homiletic  lectures  or  essays  than  critical 
commentaries  or  historical  explanations.  Again,  the  revival  of  Convo- 
cation since  the  Dictionary  first  appeared,  the  institution  of  Church 


iy  TREFAGE, 

Congresses  and  Diocesan  Conferences,  and  tlie  wonderful  development 
of  the  Colonial  Chuvch,  and  of  Missionary  enterprise  during  the  past 
thirty  years,  rendered  it  necessary  to  prepare  new  articles  upon  all 
these  subjects. 

The  same  may  be  said  of  many  questions  which,  from  various 
causes,  have  acquired  peculiar  prominence  in  the  present  day ;  such  as 
Affinity,  Endowments,  Establishment,  Vestments,  Lights  upon  the 
Altar,  the  Eastward  position,  the  Advertisements  of  Queen  Elizabeth, 
important  legal  reforms,  and  judgments  given  with  regard  to  Eitual, 
Discipline,  and  many  more.  In  dealing  with  some  matters  of  this 
kind,  which  have  been  subjects  of  much  controversy  or  litigation,  the 
arguments  on  opposite  sides  have  been  stated  by  different  writers 
in  separate  articles.  This  plan  seemed  the  most  convenient  way 
of  securing  that  impartial  attitude  which  best  becomes  a  work  of 
this  description. 

But  while  many  new  articles  have  been  inserted,  some  articles 
which  had  a  place  in  former  editions  have  been  omitted  or  very  much 
abbreviated,  because  the  subjects  of  which  they  treat  belong  more 
properly  to  the  Dictionaries  of  the  Bible,  of  Christian  Antiquities  or 
of  Christian  Biograj)hy,  and  have  been  thoroughly  dealt  with  in  those 
well-known  works,  published  under  the  Editorship  of  Dr.  Wm.  Smith. 

Although,  in  consequence  of  all  these  changes,  the  present  edition 
of  the  Dictionary  is  in  many  respects  a  new  work,  it  has  nevertheless 
been  the  desire  and  endeavour  of  the  Editors  to  abstain  from  making- 
needless  alterations,  to  preserve  articles  intact  which  bore  any 
special  impress  of  the  original  Editor's  mind,  and  above  all,  to 
adhere  throughout  to  those  principles  which  he  consistently  held 
and  advocated. 

The  Editors  have  endeavoured,  in  accordance  with  the  original 
design  of  the  work,  to  render  this  edition  as  far  as  possible  a  practical 
manual  for  the  English  Churchman,  clerical  or  lay,  furnishing  him 
with  the  real  facts  and  arguments  upon  which  the  Church  bases  and 
maintains  its  position.  They  have  for  the  most  part  referred  the 
reader,  at  the  end  of  each  article,  to  easily  accessible  works  by  trust- 
worthy writers,  in  which,  if  he  wishes  to  pursue  the  investigation  of 
any  subject  further,  he  will  find  it  more  exhaustively  treated,  and 
references  given  to  original  authorities. 

Cm-  best  thanks  are  due  to  Lord  Grimthorpe  (formerly  Sir  Edmund 
Beckett),  Chancellor  and  Vicar-General  of  York,  and  an  old  friend 
of  Dr.  Hook  when  Vicar  of  Leeds,  who  has  revised  or  written  the 
legal  and  architectural  articles,  and  several  others,  and  has  also  given 
much  valuable  assistance  and  advice.  The  legal  articles  do  not 
profess  to  be  a  complete  summary  of  ecclesiastical  law,  which  would 
require  much  more  space  than  it  would  be  proper  to  occupj-  Avith 
one  subject  in  this  book. 


PREFACE. 

The  following  is  a  list  of  other  writers  to  whom  the  Editors  are 
much  indebted  for  contributions  and  whose  initials  will  be  found  at 
the  end  of  their  articles. 

The  Very  Eev.  E.  Bickersteth,  D.D.,  Dean  of  Lichfield. 

Kev.  W.  Bright,  D.D.,  Canon  of  Christ  Church,  Professor  of  Eccle- 
siastical History,  Oxford. 

Rev.  Berdmore  Compton,  M.A. 

Rev.  Evan  Daniel,  M.A.,  Principal  of  Battersea  Training  College 
and  Hon.  Canon  of  Rochester. 

Rev.  W.  H.  David,  M.A. 

Lewis  T.  Dibdin,  Esq.,  M.A.,  Chancellor  of  Rochester. 

Rev.  H.  G.  Dickson,  M.A.,  Church  Defence  Institution. 

Rev.  T.  E.  Espin.,  D.D.,  Chancellor  and  Canon  of  Chester. 

Lord  Grimthorpe. 

Rev.  F.  Hancock,  M.A.,  Rector  of  Selworthy,  Taunton. 

Rev.  J.  G.  Howes,  SI.  A.,  Rector  of  Exford  and  Prebendary  of  Wells. 

Rev.  J.  W.  Joyce,  M.A.,  Rector  of  Burford  and  Prebendary  of 
Hereford. 

Rev.  G.  F.  Maclear,  D.D.,  Warden  of  St.  Augustine's,  Canter- 
bury. 

Rev.  B.  V.  Mills,  M.A. 

Rev.  G.  D.  W.  Ommanney,  M.A.,  Vicar  of  Draycot  and  Prebendary 
of  Wells. 

Rev.  Sir  F.  A.  G.  Ouseley,  Mus.  Doc,  LL.D.,  M.A.,  Professor  of 
Music,  Oxford. 

Miss  Lucy  Phillimore. 

Rev.  H.  W.  Tucker,  M.A.,  Sec.  of  S.P.G. 

All  other  articles  have  been  revised  or  rewritten  by  the  Editors, 
and  some  new  ones  added,  to  wliich  the  initials  H.  and  W.  R.  W.  S. 
are  respectively  annexed. 

In  conclusion,  we  pray  that  the  blessing  of  God  may  rest 
upon  our  undertaking,  and  that  the  Dictionary  in  its  present  form 
may  serve  yet  more  effectually  than  before  to  the  edification  of  the 
(Church  of  England,  for  which  the  first  compiler  of  the  work,  as  a 
parish  priest,  a  preacher  and  a  writer,  so  long  and  so  earnestly 
laboured. 

W.  HOOK. 

W.  R.  W.  STEPHENS. 


A 


CHUECH    DICTIONAEY. 


ABACUS 


A. 


member   of  a 


ABACUS.      The    upper 
capital.     (See  Capital.') 

In  Norman  architecture  the  abacus  of 
engaged  shafts  is  frequently  returned  along 
the  "waRs  in  a  continued  horizontal  string : 
perhaps  the  last  lingering  recognition  of  the 
effect  of  the  capital  in  representing  that 
horizontal  line  which  was  decided  in  the 
classic  architrave,  and  to  which  the  spirit 
of  Gothic  architecture  is  in  the  main  op- 
posed. 

ABBA.  An  Aramaean  word,  signifying 
Father,  and  derived  from  the  Hebrew  "  Ab." 
Instead  of  the  definite  article  which  the 
Hebrew  uses  before  the  word,  the  Chaldee, 
or  Aramaic,  adds  a  syllable  to  the  end, 
giving  thus  an  emphatic  form.  The  word 
"Abba"  is  expressive  of  attachment  and 
confidence,  and  was  used  by  St.  Mark,  in 
describing  the  agony  of  our  blessed  Lord,  to- 
gether with  the  Greek  equivalent,  "  'A^/3a 
6  TTarjjp " — rendered  by  Luther  "  lieber 
Vater."  (St.  Mark  xiv.  36.)  St.  Paul 
combines  the  words  in  the  same  way,  "  ye 
have  received  the  Spirit  of  adoption,  whereby 
we  cry,  '  Abba,  Father.' "  (Rom.  viii.  15 ; 
comp.  Gal.  iv.  6.) 

AJBBlS.  The  designation  assumed  in 
France,  before  the  Revolution,  by  certain 
persons,  who,  whether  in  the  higher  orders 
of  the  ministry  or  not,  ostensibly  devoted 
themselves  to  theological  studies,  in  the 
hope  that  the  king  would  confer  upon  them 
a  real  abbey,  i.e.  a  certain  portion  of  the 
revenues  of  a  real  abbey.  Hence  it  became 
the  common  title  of  unemployed  secular 
priests.  In  Italy  the  word  Abate  was 
similarly  used,  to  designate  one  who  merely 
adopted  the  clerical  habit. —  Vocdbolario  della 
Crusca. 

ABBESS.  The  Mother  or  Superior  of  a 
female  religious  community.  The  abbess 
possessed,  and  in  the  Roman  Church  still 
possesses,  the  dignity  and  authority  of  an 


ABBOT 

abbot,  with  the  exception  that  she  cannot 
exercise  the  spiritual  functions  of  the  priest- 
hood. By  a  decree  of  the  Council  of  Trent 
it  is  recommended  that  an  abbess  should 
be  at  least  40  years  of  age,  and  have  made 
profession  for  eight  years. 

ABBEY.  The  habitation  of  a  society 
devoted  to  religion.  It  signifies  a  monas- 
tery, of  which  the  head  was  an  abbot  or 
abbess.  (See  Abbot.)  Of  monastic  cathe- 
drals the  bishop  was  considered  to  be  virtu- 
ally the  abbot :  and  therefore  the  presby teral 
superior  of  these  establishments  was  styled 
Prior.  The  abbey  of  Ely  was  constituted 
a  cathedral  in  1109:  when  Herve,  Bishop 
of  Bangor,  was  translated  to  this  see.  The 
abbacy  was  henceforward  united  to  the 
bishopric :  and  therefore  it  is  that  the 
bishops  of  Ely  still  occupy  the  first  stall  on 
the  right  side  of  the  choir,  usually  assigned 
to  the  dean :  the  dean's  stall  being  the  first 
on  the  left  side,  formerly  occupied  by  the 
prior.  (See  Monasteries,  and  Walcott's 
Church  and  Conventual  Arrangements.) 

Cranmer  begged  earnestly  of  Henry  VII L 
that  he  would  save  some  of  the  abbeys,  to 
be  reformed  and  applied  to  holy  and  religious 
uses,  but  his  petition,  and  the  exertions  of 
Latimer  for  the  same  purpose,  were  in  vain. 
Even  Wolsey's  foundation  of  Christ  Church, 
Oxford,  out  of  some  of  the  confiscated  abbeys, 
escaped  with  difficulty.  (See  Brewer's 
Eenry  VIII.)  For  the  aiTangement  of  the 
several  buildings  of  an  abbey,  see  Cathedral 
and  Monastery. 

ABBOT.  The  Father  or  Superior  of  an 
abbey  of  monks,  or  male  persons,  living 
under  peculiar  religious  vows.  The  word 
abhot  comes,  through  the  late  Latin  abbas, 
from  the  Aramasan  aVba — father.  (See 
Abba.)  The  word  Father,  in  its  various 
forms  of  Papa,  Abbas,  Padre,  Pfere,  &o.,  has 
in  all  countries  and  all  ages  of  Christianity 
been  applied  as  a  title  of  respect  to  the 


2  ABBOT 

superior  clergy  and  priesthood.  In  some 
parts  of  the  East  and  in  Ireland,  this  term, 
abbas  or  abbat,  was  frequently  confounded 
with  that  of  bishop,  from  the  fact  of  the 
abbots  being  in  the  early  times  bishops  also. 
Before  the  Norman  Conquest  a  few  abbots 
sat  in  the  Witanagemote  (e.g.  5  in  a.d.  931, 
and  4  in  a.d.  934),  and  after  the  Conquest 
many  were  summoned  to  the  Great  Council 
and  ranked  next  to  the  Lords  Spiritual. 
Many  of  these  were  called  "  Mitred  "  Abbots 
because  the  right  of  wearing  the  mitre  and 
other  vestments  proper  to  the  Episcopal 
office  had  been  conferred  on  them  by  the 
Pope;  but  the  mitred  and  parliamentary 
abbots  were  not  identical.  The  abbot  of 
Tavistock,  e.g.,  although  mitred  in  the 
reign  of  Henry  VI.,  was  not  created  a 
spiritual  lord  of  parliament  till  the  reign  of 
Henry  VIII.  All  mitred  abbots  were  of 
the  Benedictine  order,  except  those  of 
Waltham  and  Cirencester,  who  were  Au- 
gustinians.     (See  Dugdale's  Monasticon.) 

There  were  some  lords  of  parliament, 
■heads  of  religious  houses,  who  were  not 
abbots :  (1.)  The  prior  of  St.  John's  of 
Jerusalem,  of  the  Knights  Hospitallers  in 
England.  He  ranked  before  the  mitred 
abbots,  and  was  considered  the  first  baron 
in  England.  (2.)  Some  monastic  priors, 
including  the  prior  of  Coventry,  a  solitary 
instance  in  England  of  the  presbyteral  head 
of  a  cathedral  being  a  spiritual  peer.  Of 
the  abbots,  the  abbot  of  Glastonbury  had 
the  precedence  till  a.d.  1154,  when  Pope 
Adrian  IV.,  an  Englishman,  from  the  af- 
fection he  entertained  for  the  place  of  his 
education,  assigned  this  precedence  to  the 
abbot  of  St.  Alban's.  In  consequence, 
Glastonbury  ranked  next  after  him,  and 
Beading  had  the  third  place.  Abbots  and 
priors  were  not  ambitious  of  sitting  in 
Parliament,  finding  attendance  to  be  a 
burden  on  their  resources,  and  in  many 
cases  they  obtained  exemption  by  proving 
that  they  were  not  tenants  in  barony  under 
the  Crown.  After  the  fourteenth  century  the 
number  attending  Parliament  steadily  di- 
minished from  80,  which  was  the  maximum 
in  1301,  down  to  27,  which  remained  the 
normal  number  until  the  Dissolution.  The 
list  summoned  in  1483  may  be  quoted  as 
a  good  average  specimen.  Peterborough, 
Colchester,  St.  Edmund's,  Abingdon,  Wal- 
tham, Shrewsbury,  Cirencester,  Gloucester, 
Westminster,  St.  Alban's,  Bardney,  Selby, 
St.  Benedict  of  Hulme,  Thorney,  Evesham, 
Eamsey,  Hyde,  Glastonbury,  Malmesbury, 
.Crowland,  Battle,  Winchcombe,  Reading, 
St.  Augustine's,  St.  Mary's  York,  prior  of 
•Coventry,  prior  of  St.  John  of  Jerusalem. 
As  the  ordinary  number  of  lay  lords  in 
Parliament  was  about  40,  the  proportion  of 
27.  abbots  was  large,  and  with  the  bishops, 


ABBREVIATION 

gave  the  ecclesiastical  element  a  consider- 
able preponderance  in  the  House  until  the 
balance  was  redressed  by  the  suppression 
of  the  monasteries.  Neither  the  I'ope  nor 
the  King  interfered  much  as  a  rule  with  the 
election  of  abbots,  and  during  the  latter 
part  of  the  middle  ages  abbots  rarely  took  a 
conspicuous  part  in  English  politics.  (See 
Bishop  Stubbs'  Constit.  Hist.  i.  125,  569 ; 
iii.  403,  443-445.) 

According  to  the  ancient  laws  of  Chris- 
tendom, confirmed  by  general  councils,  all 
heads  of  monasteries,  whether  abbots  or 
priors,  owed  canonical  obedience  to  their 
diocesan.  And  the  same  law  subsisted  till 
the  Reformation,  wherever  special  exemp- 
tions had  not  been  granted,  which,  however, 
were  numerous.  Cowell,  as  quoted  by 
Johnson  in  his  Dictionary  (tit.  Abbot), 
erroneously  says  that  the  initred  abbots 
were  exempted  from  episcopal  jurisdiction, 
but  that  the  other  sorts  (i.e.  the  non- 
mitred)  were  subject  to  their  diocesans. 
The  truth  is,  that  the  former  endeavoured 
after  their  own  aggrandizement  in  every 
possible  way,  but  had  no  inherent  right  of 
exemption  from  the  fact  of  their  being 
lords  of  parliament,  or  being  invested  with 
the  mitre.  Thus  it  appears  from  Dugd. 
Monast.  that  Gloucester,  Winchcomb,  and 
Tewkesbury  were  subject  to  the  visitation 
and  jurisdiction  of  the  bishop  of  Worcester, 
till  the  Reformation ;  Croyland,  Peter- 
borough, Bardney,  and  Ramsey  to  the 
bishop  of  Lincoln;  St.  Mary  in  York,  and 
Selby,  to  the  archbishop  of  York ;  and  Co- 
ventry to  the  bishop  of  Lichfield.  The 
abbots,  unless  specially  exempted,  took  the 
oath  of  canonical  obedience  to  their  diocesan, 
and  after  election,  were  confirmed  by  him, 
and  received  his  benediction.  (^Fuller ; 
Collier  ;  Willis's  Mitred  Abbeys.)  In  Ireland 
the  abbots  who  were  lords  of  parliament, 
were  those  of  St.  Mary,  Dublin ;  St.  Thomas, 
Dublin;  Monastereven,  Baltinglass,  Dun- 
brody,  Duisk,  Jerpoint,  Bective,  Mellifont, 
Tracton,  Monasternenagh,  Owney,  and 
Holycross.  All  these  were  of  the  Cistercian 
order,  except  the  abbot  of  St.  Thomas,  who 
was  of  St.  Victor.  The  other  parliamentary 
lords,  heads  of  religious  houses,  were  the 
cathedral  priors  of  Christ  Church,  Dublin, 
and  of.  Downpatrick;  the  priors  of  All- 
hallows,  Dublin;  Conall,  Kells,  (in  Kil- 
kenny,) Louth,  Athassel,  Killagh,  Newton, 
and  Rathboy.  All  these  were  of  the  Augus- 
tinian  order,  except  the  prior  of  Down,  who 
was  a  Benedictine,  the  preceptor  of  the 
Knights  Hospitallers  at  Wexford,  and  the 
prior  of  the  Knights  Hospitallers  at  Kil- 
mainham.     (See  Monks.) 

ABBREVJATION.  The  expression  of 
a  word  or  words  in  short.  The  most  com- 
mon ecclesiastical  abbreviations  are  I.  H.  S., 


ABDICATION 

for  Jesus  Hominum  Salvator;  St.  or  S. 
for  Saint ;  D.  G.  for  Dei  Gratia ;  A.  C.  for 
Ante  Christum;  A.  D.  for  Anno  Domini; 
A.  M.  for  Anno  Mundi ;  U.  S.  for  Old  Style, 
that  is,  the  reckoning  of  the  beginning  of 
the  year  as  it  was  before  Sept.  2, 1752,  and 
N.  S.  for  new.  (See  Old  Style.)  Also  with 
regard  to  academical  degrees :  D.  D.  for 
Divinitatis  Doctor;  B.  D.  for  Baccalaureus 
Divinitatis.  S.  T.  P.  Sanctaj  Theologiai 
Professor,  which  =  D.  D.  &c. 

ABDICATION  OP  ORDERS.  Although 
Canon  76  says  that  "  no  man  ordained 
deacon  or  priest  shall  voluntarily  relinquish 
the  same  nor  use  himself  in  the  course  of 
his  life  as  a  layman  upon  pain  of  excom- 
munication," the  Clerical  Disabilities  Act, 
1870,  allows  one  to  do  so  by  executing 
"what  is  called  a  Deed  of  Relinquishment, 
after  resigning  any  preferment  he  may  have, 
in  the  form  given  by  the  Act.  He  may 
then  enrol  it  in  Chancery,  and  may  deliver 
a  copy  of  the  enrolment  to  the  bishop  in 
■whose  diocese  he  last  held  any  preferment ; 
or  if  none,  where  he  lives :  and  may  give 
notice  to  the  archbishop.  Six  months  after 
he  has  so  delivered  a  copy  of  the  enrolment 
to  the  bishop,  the  bishop  shall,  on  his  ap- 
plication, have  it  registered ;  and  thereupon 
(but  not  before)  he  becomes  for  all  practical 
.purposes  a  lajrman.  And  as  no  man  can  be 
le-ordained  the  step  is  irrevocable.  But  if 
any  proceedings  against  him  as  a  clergy- 
man were  pending,  the  registration  is  to  be 
suspended  till  they  are  terminated;  and 
abdication  does  not  relieve  him  from  any 
.claim  for  dilapidations  or  any  other  debt. 
It  has  been  decided  that  a  clergyman  may 
stop  and  change  his  mind  at  any  of  the 
stages  prescribed  by  the  Act,  which  indeed 
was  quite  clear,  as  they  are  aU  permissive ; 
and  the  notice  to  the  archbishop  seems 
purely  optional,  and  has  no  consequences, 
and  may  be  put  in  the  fire  forthwith.    [G.] 

ABKCEDARIAN  HYMNS.  Hymns 
composed  in  imitation  of  the  acrostic  poetry 
of  the  Hebrews,  in  which  each  verse,  or 
each  part,  commenced  with  the  first  and 
succeeding  letters  of  the  alphabet,  in  their 
order.  This  aixangement  was  intended  as 
a  help  to  the  memory.  St.  Augustine 
composed  a  hymn  in  this  manner,  for  the 
common  people  to  learn,  against  the  error 
of  the  Donatists.  (See  Acrostic ;  Alplwhet 
Psalms.) 

'  ABELIANS,  Abelins,  Abelites,  or  Abel- 
onites.  A  sect  of  heretics  mentioned  by 
St.  Augustine  as  existing  in  the  diocese  of 
Hippo.  Founding  their  opinions  on  the 
idea  that  Abel  always  continued  in  a  state 
of  celibacy,  they  condemned  the  uses  of 
marriage.  If  married  themselves  they  had 
no  intercourse  with  their  wives ;  but  to  keep 
j^T^  their  numbers  they  adopted  the  children 


.  ABJUKATION  S 

of  others,  on  condition  that  they  should 
live  according  to  their  rules.  The  sect  died 
out  in  the  reign  of  Theodosius  the  Younger. 
— Soames'  Moslieim,  vol.  i.  150  (Stubbs' 
edition). 

ABEYANCE.  Coke  explains  the  term 
thus :  "  En  abeiance,  that  is,  in  expectation, 
from  the  French  hayer,  to  expect.  For 
when  a  parson  dieth,  we  .«ay  that  the  free- 
hold is  in  abeyance,  because  a  successor  is 
in  expectation  to  take  it ;  and  here  note  the 
necessity  of  the  true  interpretation  of  the 
words.  If  tenant  pur  terme  cCautre  vis 
dieth  the  freehold  is  said  to  be  in  abeyance 
untH  the  occupant  entereth.  If  a  man 
makes  a  lease  for  life,  the  remainder  to  the 
right  heirs  of  I.  S.,  the  fee  simple  is  in 
abeyance,  that  is,  in  expectation,  in  remem- 
brance, entendment,  or  consideration  of  law, 
in  cmisideratione  sive  inteUigentia  legis; 
because  it  is  not  in  any  man  living."  i(Co. 
Litt.  342,  b.)  And  if  a  man  be  patron  of  a 
church,  and  presenteth  a  clerk  to  the  same ; 
the  fee  of  the  lands  and  tenements  pertaining 
to  the  rectory  is  in  the  parson ;  but  if  the 
parson  die,  and  the  church  becometh  void, 
then  is  the  fee  in  abeyance,  until  there  be 
a  new  parson  presented,  admitted,  and 
inducted. 

ABJURATION.  A  solemn  renuncia- 
tion in  public,  or  before  a  proper  officer, 
of  some  doctrinal  error.  A  formal  abjura- 
tion was  often  considered  necessary  by  the 
Church,  when  any  person  sought  to  be  re- 
ceived into  her  communion  from  heresy  or 
schism.  Many  forms  of  abjuration  exacted 
from  persons  convicted  of  being  Lollards  or 
disciples  of  John  Wiclif,  may  be  formd 
in  the  Registers  of  English  Bishops  during 
the  fourteenth  and  fifteenth  centuries ;  also 
in  the  Fasciculi  Zizaniorum.  The  culprit  was 
generally  compelled  to  make  his  abjuration 
in  his  parish  church,  in  the  presence  of 
the  bishop ;  sometimes  in  several  parish 
-churches  in  the  diocese.  A  foi'm  for  ad- 
mitting Romish  recusants  into  the  Church 
of  England  was  drawn  up  by  one  of  the 
Houses  of  Convocation  of  1714,  but  did 
not  receive  the  royal  sanction.  This  may 
be  found  in  Cardwell's  Synodalia,  vol.  ii. 
c.  40. 

ABJURATION  OATH,  THE.  A  form 
for  renouncing  the  Stuart  dynasty,  to  be 
sworn  by  every  person  who  took  office,  civil, 
military,  or  spiritual.  It  was  first  proposed 
in  1690,  but  was  not  made  compulsory 
before  the  last  year  of  tiie  reign  of  William 
III.  It  was  reenforced  on  the  accession  of 
George  I.,  and  on  the  death  of  the  Old 
Pretender  (1765),  and  was  not  finally 
abolished  rmtil  1858.     (See  Supremacy.) 

ABJURATION  OATH  for  Scotland, 
1662.  Imposed  on  all  persons  holding 
public  office,  included  a  declaration  that 

B  2 


4  ABJTJKATION 

"tlie  Covenant  and  League  are  of  them- 
selves unlawful  oaths,  and  were  taken  and 
imposed  upon  the  subjects  of  this  kingdom 
against  the  fundamental  laws  and  liberties 
of  the  same." 

ABJURATION  OP  THE  REALM. 
An  oath  which  might  be  enforced  on  any- 
one guilty  of  felony  who  had  availed  him- 
self of  the  privilege  of  sanctuary.  It  bound 
the  offender  to  quit  the  kingdom  within 
thirty  days,  and  rendered  him  liable  to 
the  penalty  of  death  if  he  returned.  The 
oath  was  abolished  together  with  the 
privilege  of  sanctuary  in  the  time  of 
James  I.  In  the  thirty-fifth  year  of  Eliza- 
beth a  statute  was  passed  by  which  Pro- 
testant Dissenters  who  refused  to  attend 
divine  service  according  to  the  Anglican 
form,  and  Roman  Catholics,  might  be  forced 
to  abjure  the  realm,  and  if  they  refused  or 
returned  without  licence,  might  be  hanged 
as  felons.  The  Act  of  Toleration  relieved 
Protestant  Dissenters  from  the  obligation 
to  take  this  oath,  but  Romanists  were 
legally  subject  to  it  until  1791,  when  it 
was  removed  from  the  Statute  Book  ' 

ABLUTION.  Washing,  or  purification, 
either  of  the  person  or  the  sacred  vessels.. 
The  word  is  generally  used  to  signify  the 
rinsing  of  the  chalice,  after  the  Holy  Com- 
munion, with  wine  and  water,  which  are 
reverently  drunk  by  the  priest.  (Cf.  6  th 
rubric  after  communion  office.)    [H.] 

ABSOLUTION.  The  pardon  of  God  for 
sins,  pronounced  by  the  priest  to  the  peni- 
tent, in  the  name  of  God.  "If  our  con- 
fession be  serious  and  hearty,  this  absolution 
is  as  effectual  as  if  God  did  pronounce  it 
from  heaven.  So  says  the  Confession  of 
Saxony  and  Bohemia,  and  so  says  the 
Augsburg  Confession;  and,  which  is  more, 
so  says  St.  Chrysostom  in  his  fifth  homily 
upon  Isaiah,  "Heaven  waits  and  expects 
the  priest's  sentence  here  on  earth ;  the 
Lord  follows  the  servant,  and  what  the 
servant  rightly  binds  or  looses  here  on 
earth,  that  the  Lord  confirms  in  heaven." 
The  same  says  St.  Gregory  {Horn,  xxvi.)  upon 
the  Gospels :  "  The  apostles  (and  in  them 
all  priests)  were  made  God's  vicegerents 
here  on  earth,  in  his  name  and  stead  to 
retain  or  remit  sins."  St.  Augustine  and 
Cyprian,  and  generally  all  antiquity,  say  the 
same ;  so  does  our  Church  in  many  places, 
particularly  in  the  form  of  absolution  for 
the  sick ;  but,  above  all,  holy  Scripture  is 
clear  (St.  John  xx.  23),  "  Whose  soever 
sins  ye  remit,  they  are  remitted  unto 
them."  Which  power  of  remitting  sins 
was  not  to  end  with  the  apostles,  but  is  a 
part  ot  the  ministry  of  reconciliation,  as 
necessaiy  now  as  it  was  then,  and  there- 
fore to  continue  as  long  as  the  ministry  of 
reconciliation ;   that  is,  to  the  end  of  the 


ABSOLUTION 

world.  (Eph.  iv.  12,  13.)  When,  there- 
fore, the  priest  absolves,  God  absolves,  if 
we  be  truly  penitent.  Now,  this  remis- 
sion of  sins  granted  here  to  the  priest,  to 
which  God  hath  promised  a  confirmation 
in  heaven,  is  not  the  act  of  preaching,  or 
baptizing,  or  admitting  men  to  the  holy 
communion.  But  this  power  of  remitting 
sins,  mentioned  John  xx.,  was  not  granted 
(though  promised.  Matt.  xvi.  19)  till  now, 
that  is,  after  the  resurrection,  as  appears 
by  the  ceremony  of  breathing,  ■  signifying 
that  then  it  was  given :  and  secondly,  by 
the  word  receive,  used  in  that  place  (ver. 
22),  which  he  could  not  properly  have 
used,  if  they  had  been  endued  with  this 
power  before.  Therefore  the  power  of 
remitting,  which  here  God  authorizes,  and 
promises  certain  assistance  to,  is  neither 
preaching  nor  baptizing,  but  some  other  way 
of  remitting,  viz.  that  which  the  Church 
calls  absolution.  And  if  it  be  so,  then,  to 
doubt  of  the  effect  of  it  (supposing  we  be 
truly  penitent,  and  such  as  God  will 
pardon)  is  to  question  the  truth  of  God : 
and  he  that,  under  pretence  of  reverence  to 
God,  denies  or  despises  this  power,  does 
injury  to  God,  slighting  his  commission,  and 
is  no  better  than  a  Novatian,  says  St. 
Ambrose. — Sparrow. 

"  Sacerdotal  absolution  does  not  neces- 
sarily require  any  particular  or  auricular 
confession  of  private  sins;  forasmuch  as 
that  the  grand  absolution  of  baptism  was 
commonly  given  without  any  particular 
confession.  And  therefore  the  Romanists 
vainly  found  the  necessity  of  auricular  con- 
fession upon  those  words  of  our  Saviour, 
Whose  soever  sins  ye  remit,  they  are  re- 
mitted unto  them :  as  if  there  could  be  no 
absolution  without  particular  confession ; 
when  it  is  so  plain,  tliat  the  great  absolution 
of  baptism  (the  j)ower  of  which  is  founded 
by  the  ancients  upon  this  ver}'  place)  re- 
quired no  such  particular  confession.  We 
may  hence  infer,  that  the  power  of  any 
sacerdotal  absolution  is  only  ministerial; 
because  the  administration  of  baptism 
(which  is  the  most  universal  absolution), 
so  far  as  man  is  concerned  in  it,  is  no 
more  than  ministerial.  All  the  ofiBce  and 
power  of  man  in  it  is_only  to  minister  the 
external  form,  but  the  internal  power  and 
grace  of  remission  of  sins  is  properly  Grod's  ; 
and  so  it  is  in  all  other  sorts  of  absolution." 
— Bingham,  Ant.  bk.  xix.  c.  1,  2. 

Calvin's  liturgy  has  no  form  of  absolution 
in  it :  but  he  himself  says  that  it  was  an 
omission  in  him  at  first,  and  a  defect  in  his 
liturgy;  which  he  afterwards  would  have 
rectified  and  amended,  but  could  not.  He 
makes  this  ingenuous  confession  in  one  of 
his  epistles :  "  There  is  none  of  us,"  says 
he,  "  but  must  acknowledge  it  to  be  very 


ABSOLUTION 

useful,  that,  after  tlie  general  confession, 
some  remarkable  promise  of  Scripture 
should  follow,  whereby  sinners  might  be 
raised  to  the  hopes  of  pardon  and  recon- 
ciliation. And  I  would  have  introduced 
this  custom  from  the  beginning,  but  some 
fearing  that  the  novelty  of  it  would  give 
offence,  I  was  over-easy  in  yielding  to 
them ;  so  the  thing  was  omitted."  I  must 
do  that  justice  to  Calvin  here,  by  the  way, 
to  say,  that  he  was  no  enemy  to  private 
absolution  neither,  as  used  in  the  Church 
of  England.  For  in  one  of  his  answers  to 
Westphalus  he  thus  expresses  his  mind 
about  it :  "I  have  no  intent  to  deny  the 
usefulness  of  private  absolution  :  but  as  I 
commended  it  in  sevei-al  places  of  my 
■writings,  provided  the  use  be  left  to  men's 
liberty,  and  free  from  superstition,  so  to 
bind  men's  consciences  by  a  law  to  it,  is 
neither  lawful  nor  expedient."  Here  we 
have  Calvin's  judgment,  fully  and  entirely, 
for  the  usefulness  both  of  public  and  private 
absolution.  He  owns  it  to  be  a  defect  in 
his  liturgy,  that  it  wants  a  public  absolution. 
—Bingham,  Tracts,  vol.  viii.  [1840].     [H.] 

ABSOLUTION,  FORMS  OF.  I.  The  old 
form  of  absolution  at  Prime  and  Compline 
was, "  The  Almighty  and  merciful  Lord  grant 
you  absolution  and  remission  of  all  your 
sins,  and  space  for  true  repentance,  amend- 
ment of  life,  and  the  grace,  and  consolation 
of  the  Holy  Spirit."  This  was  preceded 
by  a  form  of  confession  used  fii'st  by  the 
priest  and  afterwards  by  the  choir.  The 
present  form  was  composed  in  1552.  The 
rubric  originally  ran,  "  The  absolution  to  be 
pronounced  by  the  minister  alone."  The 
■words  "  or  remission  of  sins "  were  added 
after  the  Hampton  Court  Conference  (1604:). 
This  is  said  to  have  been  a  concession  to  the 
Puritans ;  but  the  word  Absolution  was  not 
superseded,  and  the  addition  would  seem  to 
show  that  the  divines  there  assembled  held 
that  this  was  not  merely  a  declaration  of 
God's  mercy,  but  an  absolution  of  penitent 
sinners.  The  word  "  minister  "  in  the  service 
was  changed  to  priest  in  1661 ;  and  the 
word  "  standing  "  was  also  introduced  at  the 
last  revision,  at  the  instance  of  Bishop  Cosin, 
for  though  it  had  hitherto  been  the  custom, 
yet  carelessness  was  creeping  on  in  this 
respect ;  and  as  Bishop  Andrewes  had 
■written,  "  as  he  speaks  it  authoritative,  in 
the  name  of  Christ  and  His  Church,  the 
minister  must  not  kneel  but  stand  up." 

IL  In  the  order  for  Holy  Communion, 
the  latter  part  of  the  absolution  is  almost 
an  exact  rendering  of  the  form  in  the  Sarum 
Use,  the  first  part  resembles  that  in  Her- 
ma,nn's  Consultation.  It  was  placed  in  its 
present  position  in  1552. 

III.  The  absolution  in  the  Visitation  of 
the  Sick  differs  from  the  other  two  in  being 


ABSTINENCE  5 

more  authoritative  in  its  language.  The 
formula  has  come  down  unaltered  from 
1549,  and  seems  to  have  been  based  oh  that 
in  the  Sarum  office.  The  rubric  of  1549 
concluded  with  the  direction,  "and  the 
same  form  of  absolution  shall  be  used  in  all 
private  confessions."  But  this  was  omitted 
in  1552.  The  ministerial  absolution  of 
persons  unquiet  in  conscience,  before  re- 
ceiving the  holy  communion,  is  mentioned 
in  the  first  exhortation  on  giving  notice  of 
the  communion;  and  the  absolution  of  ex- 
communicated persons  in  the  65th  Canon. 

Bingham  (Lib.  xix.  c.  ii.)  says  with 
regard  to  the  indicative  form  (I  absolve 
thee)  that  "  Morinas  proves  that  it  did  not 
take  the  place  of  the  deprecatory  form  (Christ 
absolve  thee)  till  the  twelfth  or  thirteenth 
centuries,  not  long  before  the  time  of 
Thomas  Aquinas,  who  was  one  of  the  first 
that  wrote  In  defence  of  it,  and  Bishop 
Usher  ('Ans.  to  Jesuit's  Challenge,'  p.  89)  has 
proved  the  novelty  of  it  from  Aquinas 
himself."  {Ant.  xix.,  ii.  5.)  Palmer  re- 
marks, "  An  absolution  followed  the  confes- 
sion formerly  in  the  ofSces  of  the  English 
Churches,  for  prime,  or  the  first  hour  of  the 
day.  We  may  perhaps  assign  to  the  absolu- 
tion thus  placed  an  antiquity  equal  to  that 
of  the  confession,  though  Gemma  Ardmai 
and  Durandus  do  not  appear  expressly  to 
mention  it.  The  sacerdotal  benediction  of 
penitents  was  in  the  earhest  times  conveyed 
in  the  form  of  a  prayer  to  God  for  their 
absolution ;  but,  in  after  ages,  different 
forms  of  benediction  were  used,  both  in  the 
East  and  West.  With  regard  to  these 
varieties  of  farm,  it  does  not  appear  that 
they  were  formerly  considered  of  any  impor- 
tance. A  benediction  seems  to  have  been 
regarded  as  equally  valid,  whether  it  was 
conveyed  in  the  form  of  a  petition  or  a 
declaration,  whether  in  the  optative  or  the 
indicative  mood,  whether  in  the  active  or 
the  passive  voice,  whether  in  the  first, 
second,  or  third  person.  It  is  true  that  a 
direct  prayer  to  God  is  a  most  ancient  form 
of  blessing ;  but  the  use  of  a  precatory,  or 
an  optative  form,  by  no  means  warrants  the 
inference,  that  the  person  who  uses  it  is 
devoid  of  any  divinely  instituted  authority 
to  bless  and  absolve  in  the  congregation  of 
God.  Neither  does  the  use  of  a  direct 
indicative  form  of  blessing  or  absolution 
imply  anything  but  the  exercise  of  an 
authority  which  God  has  given,  to  such  an 
extent,  and  under  such  limitations,  as 
Divine  revelation  has  declared." — Palmer's 
Orig.  Liturg.  vol.  i.  p.  242. 

ABSTINENCE.  The  refraining  from 
indulgence  especially  in  the  use  of  food.  In 
the  Roman  Church,  fasting  and  abstinance 
admit  of  a  distinction,  and  different  days 
are  appointed  for  each  of  them.     On  their 


6  ABSTINElSrCE 

days  of  fasting,  they  are  allowed  but  one 
meal  in  four  and  twenty  liouvs;  but,  on 
days  of  abstinence,  provided  they  abstain 
from  flesh,  and  make  but  a  moderate  meal, 
they  are  indulged  in  a  collation  at  night. 
The  times  by  them  set  apart  for  the  first 
are,  all  Lent,  except  Sundays,  the  Ember 
days,  the  vigils  of  the  more  solemn  feasts, 
and  all  Fridays  except  those  that  fall  within 
the  twelve  days  of  Christmas,  and  between 
Easter  and  the  Ascension.  Their  days  of 
abstinence  are  all  the  Sundays  in  Lent,  St. 
Mark's  day,  if  it  does  not'  fall  in  Easter 
week,  the  three  Eogation  days,  all  Satur- 
days throughout  the  year,  with  thfe- Fridays 
1  before  excepted,  unless  either  happen  to  be 
Christmas  day.  The  reason  why  they 
observe  St.  Mark's  as  a  day  of  abstinence  is, 
as  we  learn  from  their  own  books,  in  imita- 
tion of  St.  Mark's  disciples,  the  first  Chris- 
tians of  Alexandria,  who,  under  this  saint's 
conduct,  were  eminent  for  their  great  prayer, 
abstinence,  and  sobriety.  They  further  tell 
us,  that  St.  Gregory  the  Grcar,  the  apostle 
of  England,  first  set  apart  this  day  for 
abstinence  and  public  prayer,  as  an  acknow- 
ledgment of  the  Divine  mercy,  in  putting  a 
stop  to  a  mortality  in  his  time  at  Rome. 

We  do  not  find  that  the  Church  of  England 
makes  any  diiference  between  days  of  fasting 
and  days  of  abstinence.  _  It  is  true,  in  the 
title  of  the  table  of  Vigils,  &o.,  she  mentions 
fasts  and  days  of  abstinence  separately  ;  but 
when  she  comes  to  enumerate  the  par- 
ticulars, she  calls  them  all  days  of  fasting 
or  abstinence,  without  distinguishing  be- 
tween the  one  and  the  other.  Nor  does  she 
anywhere  point  out  to  us  what  food  is 
proper  for  such  times  or  seasons,  or  seem  to 
place  any  part  of  religion  in  abstaining  from 
any  particular  kinds  of  meat.  It  is  true,  by 
a  statute  (5  Eliz.  5)  none  were  allowed  to 
eat  flesh  on  fish-days  (which  are  there 
declared  to  be  all  Wednesdays,  Fridays,  and 
Saturdays  in  the  year,)  without  a  licence 
first  obtained,  for  which  they  are  to  pay  a 
yearly  fine  (except  such  as  are  sick,  who 
may  be  licensed  either  by  the  bishop  or 
minister,)  under  penalty  of  three  pounds' 
forfeiture,  or  three  months'  imprisonment 
without  bail,  and  of  forty  shillings  forfeiture 
for  any  master  of  a  family  that  suffers  or 
conceals  it.  But  then  this  is  declared  to  be 
a  mere  political  law,  for  the  increase  of 
fishermen  and  mariners,  and  repairing  of 
port  towns  and  navigation,  and  not  for  any 
superstition  to  be  maintained  in  the  choice 
of  meats.  For,  by  the  same  Act,  whosoever, 
by  preaching,  teaching,  writing,  &c.,  affirms 
it  to  be  necessary  to  abstain  from  flesh  for 
the  saving  of  the  soul  of  man,  or  for  the 
service  of  God,  otherwise  than  other  politic 
laws  are  or  be,  is  to  be  punished  as  a  spreader 
of  false  news.     That  is,  he  must  suffer  ini- 


ACGESSION 

prisonment  till  he  produce  the  author ;  and, 
if  he  cannot  produce  him,  must  be  punished 
at  the  discretion  of  the  king's  council.  The 
sections  of  this  Act  which  relate  to  eating 
fish  on  Wednesdays,  were  repealed  by  27 
Eliz.  c.  11. 

With  us,  therefore,  neither  Church  nor 
State  makes  any  difference  in  the  kinds  of 
meat ;  but  as  far  as  the  former  determines 
in  the  matter,  she  seems  to  recommend  an 
entire  abstinence  from  all  manner  of  food 
till  the  time  of  fasting  be  over;  declaring 
in  her  homilies,  that  fasting  (by  the  decree 
of  the  six  hundred  and  thirty  fathers,  as- 
sembled at  the  Council  of  Chaloedon,  which 
was  one  of  the  four  first  general  councils, 
who  grounded  their  determination  upon  the 
sacred  Scriptures,  and  long-continued  usage 
or  practice  both  of  the  prophets  and  other 
godly  persons,  before  the  coming  of  Christ, 
and  also  of  the  apostles  and  other  devout 
men  in  the  New  Testament)  is  a  withholding 
of  meat,  drink,  and  all  natural  food  from 
the  body,  for  the  determined  time  of  fasting. 
—  Wlieatly.    (See  Fasting.) 

ABYSSINIA.  The  Abyssinian  Church 
was  founded  early  in  the  fourth  century. 
Its  first  bishoiD,  Frumentius,  received  conse- 
cration from  St.  Athanasius,  bishop  of 
Alexandria,  and  to  this  day  the  Abund  of 
Abyssinia  is  always  an  Egyptian  monk, 
chosen  and  consecrated  by  the  Coptic  patri- 
arch. In  the  sixth  century  the  Christians 
of  Abyssinia  fell  into  the  heresy  of  the 
Monophysites,  in  which  they  still  remain ; 
and  they  also  agree  with  the  Greek  Church 
in  denying  the  procession  of  the  Holy 
Ghost  from  the  Son.  In  the  fifth,  and 
again  in  the  seventeenth  century,  attempts 
were  made  to  reduce  the  Abyssinian  Chris- 
tians to  obedience  to  the  Roman  see,  but  the 
attempt  in  both  instances  utterly  failed. 
The  number  of  Christians  in  Abyssinia  is 
said  to  amount  to  three  millions. 

ACCESS,  Prayer  of  Humble.  The 
prayer  offered  immediately  before  the  Prayer 
of  Consecration  in  the  Office  of  Holy  Com- 
munion. In  the  Liturgies  of  1548  and  1549 
the  Invitation  ("  Te  that  do  truly,"  &c.), 
the  Confession,  the  Absolution,  the  "  Com- 
fortable Words,"  and  this  prayer,  were  placed 
between  the  Consecration  and  the  actual 
Communion.  This  order  is  observed  in  the 
Scottish  Office.  The  alteration  in  .tbe 
English  Office  was  made  in  1552,  so  that 
the  consecration  of  the  Elements,  and  the 
reception  of  the  faithful,  should  come  as 
near  as  possible  together.  In  the  Eastern 
Liturgies  the  prayer  which  corresponds  to 
this  is  called  the  "  Prayer  of  Inclination," 
and  is  used  immediately  before  the  com- 
munion of  the  people.     [H.] 

ACCESSION  SERVICE.  The  first  form 
of  prayer,  with  Thanksgiving  to  be  used  on 


ACCESSOEIES 

the  anniversary  of  the  Sovereign's  accession 
to  the  Throne,  was  set  forth  "  by  authority  " 
in  1578,  and  was  to  be  used  on  Nov.  17,  the 
day  of  Queen  EHzabeth's  accession.  In 
1626  a  new  form  was  published  by  the 
king's  authority,  and  sanctioned  by  Con- 
vocation in  1640.  This  was  superseded  in 
1661  by  the  Service  of  Thanksgiving  for 
the  Restoration  to  be  held  on  May  29.  In 
James  II.'s  reign  the  Accession  service 
was  revived,  and,  with  the  exception  of  the 
prayer,  an  entirely  new  form  was  prepared. 
This  was  again  revived  in  Queen  Anne's 
reign  (1703-^),  and  as  so  revived  (with  the 
exception  of  the  alteration  of  the  first  lesson 
from  Prov.  viii.  13  to  Josh.  i.  1-9,  the  latter 
being  the  lesson  in  King  James'  form)  is 
the  form  now  enjoined  for  use  on  June  20, 
the  anniversary  of  Her  Majesty's  accession. 
(See  State  Prayers.) 

ACCESSORIES  OF  DIVINE  SERVICE. 
The  rule  with  regard  to  these  is  briefly 
comprehended  in  the  Rubric,  "  And  here  it 
is  to  be  noted,  that  such  ornaments  of  the 
Church,  and  of  the  ministers  thereof,  at  all 
times  of  their  ministration,  shall  be  retained, 
and  be  in  use  as  were  in  this  Church  of 
England,  by  the  Authority  of  Parliament, 
in  the  2nd  year  of  the  reign  of  King  Edward 
the  sixth."  This  is  substantially  the  same 
as  the  rubric  in  the  Prayer  Book  of  1559, 
which  was  incorporated  with  the  Elizabethan 
Act  of  Uniformity  (1  Eliz.  c.  2,  §  25),  was 
retained  in  the  Prayer  Book  of  James  I.,  and 
was  re-enacted  at  the  last  revision  in  1661. 
• — Perry  in  Blunt's  Annotated  Prayer  Booh. 
ACCUSTOMED  DUTY  to  the  Priest 
and  Clerk.  That  which  is  ordered  by  the 
rubric  in  the  Marriage  Service  to  be  "  laid 
on  the  book  together  with  the  ring,  imme- 
diately before  the  solemn  placing  of  the 
ring  upon  the  finger  of  the  bride.  In  olden 
times  gold,  silver,  and  a  ring  were  given  at 
this  part  of  the  service,  but  the  gold  and 
silver  was  not  intended  as  a  fee,  but  as  a 
symbol  of  dowry.  The  old  form  in  the 
Prayer  Book  of  1549  was  "  With  this  ring  I 
thee  wed,  this  gold  and  silver  I  thee  give." 
In  the  York  Use  the  form  was  "  With  this 
ringe  I  wedde  the,  and  with  this  gold  and 
silver  I  honoure  the,  and  with  this  gift  I 
honoure  the.  In  nomine,"  &c.  An  old 
Manual  in  the  British  Museum  explains  the 
object  of  the  gold  and  silver  "  in  signifyinge 
that  the  woman  schal  haue  pure  dower,  thi 
goods  if  heo  abide  aftur  thy  disces  "  (Blunt). 
Hooker  {Ecc.  Pol.  v.  Ixxiii.  6)  thinks  that 
the  custom  may  be  traced  to  the  old  Saxon 
practice  of  buying  wives.  The  rubric  was 
changed  to  its  present  form  in  1552 ;  but  as 
a  rule  the  fees  are  not  laid  upon  the  book 
during  the  service. 

ACEPHALI.     (a  and  K«^dKr),  literally, 
without  a  head.)    The  name  given  to  those 


ACROSTIC  7 

of  the  Egyptian  Eutyohians,  who,  after 
Peter  Mongus,  bishop  of  Alexandria,  had 
signed  the  IJenoticon  of  Zeno,  a.d.  482, 
formed  a  separate  sect.     (See  Henoticon.') 

The  Egyptians  had  since  the  Council  of 
Chalcedon  renounced  Eutyohes  as  their 
leader  and  assumed  the  more  appropriate 
name  of  "  Monophysites."  When  some  of 
them  also  renounced  Peter  Mongus,  they 
were  indeed  "  without  a  head."  Yet  all  the 
branches  of  this  sect  continued  to  bear  the 
name  of  Monojjhysites  till  late  in  the  sixth 
century,  when  they  assumed  the  name  of 
Jacobites  (from  Jacobus  Baradeus),  which 
they  still  bear. — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim, 
i.  377,  and  408,  note;  Suicer  v.  dxt'^aXoi. 
(See  Monophysite.) 

ACOEMET^.  (;hKoiii.rrrai,  Watchers.) 
An  order  of  monks  instituted  at  the  begin- 
ning of  the  fifth  century  at  Constantinople. 
They  were  divided  into  three  classes,  who 
performed  the  Divine  service  by  rotation, 
and  so  continued  night  and  day  without 
intermission. 

ACOLYTH,  or  ACOLYTE,  (aKoXovBbs,) 
in  our  old  English  called  "  Collet,"  was  an 
inferior  church  servant,  who,  next  under 
the  subdeacon,  waited  on  the  priests  and 
deacons,  and  performed  the  meaner  ofiices 
of  lighting  the  tapers,  carrying  the  candle- 
sticks and  pot  of  incense,  and  preparing  the 
wine  and  water.  Acolytes  were  admitted 
at  the  age  of  14.  (See  Age.)  The  order  • 
seems  not  to  have  existed  in  the  Eastern 
Church  for  more  than  400  years,  being 
mentioned  for  the  first  time  in  the  age  of 
Justinian. 

ACROSTIC.  A  form  of  poetical  com- 
position among  the  Hebrews,  composed  of 
twenty-two  lines,  or  stanzas,  according  to 
the  number  of  letters  in  the  Hebrew  alpha- 
bet, each  line  or  stanza  beginning  with 
each  letter  in  its  order.  Of  the  several 
poems  of  this  character,  there  are  twelve 
in  all,  in  the  Old  Testament,  viz.  Psalms 
XXV.,  xxxiv.,  xxxvii.,  cxi.,  cxii.,  cxix.,  cxlv.. 
Part  of  Proverbs  xxxi.,  Lament,  i.,  ii., 
iii.,  iv.  Psalm  cxix.  is  the  most  remark- 
able specimen.  It  still  retains  in  the  Bible 
translation  the  name  of  the  letters  of  the 
Hebrew  alphabet,  to  mark  its  several 
divisions.  This  Psalm  consists  of  twenty- 
two  stanzas,  (the  number  of  the  letters 
of  the  Hebrew  alphabet,)  each  division 
consisting  of  eight  couplets ;  the  first  line 
of  each  couplet  beginning  with  that  letter 
of  the  alphabet  which  marks  the  division. 
Psalm  xxxvii.  consists  of  twenty-two  qua- 
trains ;  the  first  line  only  of  each  quatrain 
being  acrostical :  Lam.  i.  and  ii.,  of  twenty- 
two  triplets,  the  first  line  of  each  only  be- 
ing acrostical :  Lam.  iii.,  of  twenty-two 
triplets  also,  but  with  every  line  acrostical : 
Lam.   iv.   and   Psalms    xxv.,   xxxiv.,   and 


8  ACTS 

cxv.,  and  part  of  Prov.  xxxi.,  of  twenty- 
two  couplets,  the  first  line  only  of  each 
heing  aorostical :  Psalms  cxi.  and  cxil.,  of 
twenty-two  lines  each,  in  alphabetical  or- 
der. The  divisions  of  the  Hebrew  poetry 
into  lines,  not  metrical,  but  rhythmical  and 
parallel  in  sentiment,  is  very  much  eluci- 
dated by  the  alphabetical  o.  acrostical 
poems. 

ACTS  OF  THE  APOSTLES.  A  second 
treatise  by  the  author  of  the  third  gospel— 
St.  Luke.  The  similarity  of  style  and 
idiom,  and  the  usage  of  particular  words 
and  compound  forms  strongly  show  the 
identity  of  the  writer  of  both  booljs.  It  is 
probable  that  the  place  of  v?riting  was 
Eome,  and  the  time  about  two  years  from 
the  date  of  St.  Paul's  arrival  there  as  related 
in  Acts  xxviii.  The  genuineness  of  the 
Acts  has  ever  been  recognised  in  the 
Church.  (See  Salmon's  Introduction  to  N.  T.) 

ADAMITES.  A  sect  that  arose  in  the 
second  century,  followers  of  Prodicus,  a 
disciple  of  Carpocrates.  Wishing  to  imitate 
the  state  of  innocence  before  the  fall,  they 
met  together  for  worship  in  a  naked  state. 
In  the  fifteenth  century  a  similar  sect  arose 
called  "  Beghards " ;  or,  as  the  Bohemians 
pronounced  it,  "  Pioards."  (See  Picards.) 
— Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  vol.  i.  150  ;  vol. 
ii.  363. 

ADMINISTEATOE.  An  ancient  of- 
ficer of  the  Church,  whose  duty  was  to  de- 
fend the  cause  of  the  widows,  orphans, 
and  all  others  who  might  be  destitute  of 
help. 

ADMINISTRATION,  in  an  ecclesiasti- 
cal sense,  is  used  to  express  the  giving  or 
dispensing  the  sacraments  of  our  Lord. 

ADMONITION,  or  MONITION.  L  A 
part  of  discipline  used  in  the  ancient  Church. 
It  was  the  first  act  against  an  offender,  and 
was  solemnly  repeated  once  or  twice  before 
proceeding  to  greater  severities.  According 
to  the  Apostle's  advice,  "  A  man  that  is  an 
heretic  after  the  first  and  second  admonition 
reject."  (Tit.  iii.  10.)  This  part  of  episco- 
pal discipline  precedes  excommunication. — 
Ambrose,  de  Offic.  ii.  27  ;  Bingham,  xvi.  2. 

In  England  the  Act  53  George  III.  c.  127, 
"  for  the  better  regulation  of  Ecclesiastical 
Courts  in  England,"  directed  the  disuse  of 
excommunication,  and  consequently  of  "  ad- 
monition" in  this  sense,  and  substituted  a 
writ  "  de  contumace  capiendo "  for  the  old 
writ "  de  excommunicato  capiendo." 

II.  The  term  admonition  in  the  "  Ordinal " 
is  used  in.a  different  sense,  and  implies  subor- 
dination to  the  ordinary,  and  superior  priest. 
— Bishop  Barry's  P.  B. 

ADMONITIONISTS.  Certain  Puritans 
in  the  reign  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  who  were 
so  called  from  being  the  authors  of  the 
"  Admonition  to  the  Parliament,"  1571,  in 


ADVENT 

which  everything  in  the  Church  of  Eng- 
land was  condemned,  which  was  not  after 
the  fashion  of  Geneva.  They  required 
every  ceremony  to  be  "  commanded  in  the 
Word,"  and  set  at  nought  all  general  rules 
and  canons  of  the  Church. 

ADOPTIONISTS.  Heretics  m  several 
parts  of  Spain,  who  held  that  our  Saviour 
was  God  only  by  adoption.  Their  notions 
were  condemned  at  Frankfort  in  the  year 
794. 

ADOPTION.  To  adopt  is  to  make  him  a 
son  who  was  not  so  by  birth.  The  Catechism 
teaches  us  that  it  is  in  holy  baptism  that 
"  we  are  made  members  of  Christ,  children 
of  God,  and  inheritors  of  the  kingdom  of 
heaven."  God  sent  forth  his  Son  to  redeem 
them  that  were  under  the  law,  that  we  might 
receive  the  adoption  of  sons.     (Gal.  iv.  4,  5.) 

ADORATION.  This  word  signifies  a 
particular  sort  of  worship,  which  the  Pagans 
gave  to  their  deities :  but,  amongst  Chris- 
tians, it  is  used  for  the  general  reverence  and 
worship  paid  to  God.  The  heathens  paid 
their  regard  to  their  gods  by  putting  their 
hands  to  their  mouths  and  kissing  them. 
This  was  done  in  some  places  standing,  and 
sometimes  kneeling ;  their  faces  were  usually 
covered  in  their  worship,  and  sometimes 
they  threw  themselves  prostrate  on  the 
ground.  The  first  Christians  in  their  public 
prayers  were  wont  to  stand ;  and  this  they 
did  always  on  Sundays,  aud  on  the  fifty 
days  between  Easter  and  Pentecost  in 
memory  of  our  Lord's  resurrection,  as  is 
still  common  in  the  Eastern  Churches.  They 
were  wont  to  turn  their  faces  towards  the 
east,  perhaps  because  the  "  Day-Spring  "  is 
a  title  given  to  Christ  in  the  Old  Testa- 
ment (as  by  Zechariah  vi.  12,  according  to 
the  Septuagint  and  the  Latin  Vulgate,)  and 
by  this  act  they  testified  their  belief  in  Him 
as  the  Sun  of  righteousness. 

ADULT  BAPTISM.     (See  Baptism.) 

ADVENT.  "  For  the  greater  solemnity  of 
the  three  principal  holidays,  Christmas  day, 
Easter  day,  and  Whit-Sunday,  the  Church 
hath  appointed  certain  days  to  attend  them : 
some  to  go  before,  and  others  to  come  after 
them.  Before  Christmas  are  appointed  four 
'Advent  Sundays,'  so  called  because  the 
design  of  them  is  to  prepare  us  for  a  religious 
commemoration  of  the  advent  or  coming  of 
Christ  in  the  flesh.  The  Roman  rituaUsts 
would  have  the  celebration  of  this  holy 
season  to  be  apostolical,  and  that  it  was 
instituted  by  St.  Peter.  But  the  precise 
time  of  its  institution  is  not  so  easily  to  be 
determined,  though  it  certainly  had  its 
beginning  before  the  year  450,  because 
Maximus  Taurinensis,  who  lived  about  that 
time,  writ  a  homily  upon  it.  And  it  is  to 
be  observed,  that,  for  the  more  strict  and 
religious  observation'  of  this  season,  courses 


ADVEKTISEMENTS 

of  sermons  were  formerly  preached  in  several 
cathedrals  on  Wednesdays  and  Fridays,  as  is 
now  the  usual  practice  in  Lent.  And  we 
find  by  the  Salisbury  Missal,  that,  before  the 
Reformation,  there  was  a  special  Epistle 
and  Gospel  relating  to  Christ's  advent, 
appointed  for  those  days  during  all  that 
time." — Wheatly. 

In  the  Gallican  Church  in  the  sixth  cen- 
tury the  season  of  Advent  was  reckoned 
from  St.  Martin's  Day  (November  11),  and 
included  six  Sundays  and  a  forty  days'  fast 
called  the  Quadragesima  S.  Martini.  This 
practice  has  been  maintained  in  the  Orthodox 
Greek  Church  to  the  present  day.  The 
present  rule  in  the  Western  Chm-ch  is  that 
the  first  Sunday  in  Advent  is  the  nearest 
Sunday,  whether  before  or  after,  to  St. 
Andrew's  Day  (November  30). 

It  should  be  observed  here,  that  it  is  the 
peculiar  computation  of  the  Church  to  begin 
her  year,  and  to  renew  the  annual  course  of 
her  service,  at  this  time  of  Advent,  therein 
differing  from  all  other  accounts  of  time 
whatsoever.  The  reason  of  which  is,  because 
she  does  not  number  her  days,  or  measure 
her  seasons,  so  much  by  the  motion  of  the 
sun,  as  by  the  course  of  our  Saviour;  be- 
ginning and  counting  on  her  year  with  him, 
who,  being  the  true  "  Sun  of  righteousness," 
hegan  now  to  rise  upon  the  world,  and,  as 
"  the  Day-star  on  high,"  to  enlighten  them 
that  sat  in  spiritual  darkness. — Bp.  Cosin, 
Wheatly, 

The  lessons  and  services,  therefore,  for  the 
first  four  Sundays  in  her  liturgical  year, 
propose  to  our  meditations  the  twofold  ad- 
vent of  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ;  teaching 
us  that  it  is  he  who  was  to  come,  and  did 
come,  to  redeem  the  world ;  and  that  it  is  he 
also  who  shall  come  again,  to  be  our  judge. 
The  end  proposed  by  the  Church  in  setting 
these  two  appearances  of  Christ  together 
before  us,  at  this  time,  is  to  beget  in  our 
minds  proper  dispositions  to  celebrate  the 
one  and  expect  the  other ;  that  so  with  joy 
and  thankfulness  we  may  now  "  go  to  Beth- 
lehem, and  see  this  great  thing  which  is 
come  to  pass,  which  the  Lord  hath  made 
known  to  us,"  even  the  Son  of  God  come  to 
visit  us  in  great  humility ;  and  thence,  with 
faith  unfeigned  and  hope  immovable,  ascend 
in  heart  and  mind  to  meet  the  same  Son  of 
God  in  the  air,  coming  in  glorious  majesty 
to  judge  the  quick  and  dead. — Bp.  Home. 

Advent  Sunday  is  one  of  the  four  whose 
lessons  are  given  precedence  over  those  of 
any  conflicting  feast  by  the  new  lectionary 
rubric  of  1870.     [H.] 

ADVEKTISEMENTS  OP  QUEEN 
ELIZABETH.  I.  These  are  the  orders  re- 
ferred to  in  the  24th  Canon  as  the  Advertise- 
ments published  in  the  7th  year  of  Eliza- 
beth, and  they  have  lately  regained  so  much 


ADVERTISEMENTS  9 

importance  from  the  lawsuits  about  the 
"  ornaments  of  the  clergy  "  under  the  rubric 
at  the  beginning  of  the  present  Prayer  Book,' 
that  it  is  necessary  to  explain  their  legal 
position :  which,  it  is  also  necessary  to  in- 
form non-legal  readers,  has  not  to  be  deter- 
mined by  abstract  historical  speculations,  as 
if  they  were  an  isolated  event  with  no  abiding 
consequences,  but  in  accordance  with  settled 
legal  principles.  One  is  that  in  the  absence 
of  decisive  proof  to  the  contrary  omnia 
proesumuntur  rite  acta  as  to  the  acts  re- 
quired for  a  legal  origin  of  any  long- 
established  usage.  Judges  have  said  they 
would  presmne  a  legal  conveyance  of  an 
estate,  a  royal  dispensation  from  college 
statutes,  and  even  a  private  Act  of  Parlia- 
ment, if  necessary.  In  this  case,  if  there 
were  no  contemporaneous  evidence  at  all,  the 
requisite  royal  order  would  be  presumed, 
seeing  that  all  the  subsequent  usage  assumed 
it.  Another  maxim,  or  perhaps  the  same  in 
other  words,  is  that  long  usage  proves  its 
own  legal  origin,  if  such  an  origin  was 
possible  under  the  law  of  England ;  which  it 
certainly  was  in  this  case,  because  it  was 
expressly  provided  for  by  Act  of  Parliament. 
If  it  were  not  so,  the  consequence  would  be 
that  the  longer  any  usage  or  interpretation 
of  a  document  or  law  has  lasted,  the  more 
likely  it  would  be  to  be  upset  as  soon  as  it 
came  into  Court,  because  the  more  probably 
would  all  the  original  evidence  have  perished. 
Moreover,  long  public  usage  shows  that  it 
would  probably  have  been  enacted  if  it  had 
not  been  already  understood  to  be  law  :  and 
it  would  be  absurd  if  that  general  under- 
standing were  now  to  be  made  a  cause  for 
holding  it  to  be  unlawful.  Amateur  lawyers 
often  have  to  learn  that  the  plain  meaning 
and  positive  assertions  of  old  documents  are 
not  allowed  to  be  set  aside  by  ingenious 
conjectures  that  they  may  have  meant,  or 
ought  to  have  meant,  and  said,  something 
else.  The  legal  history  of  "  the  Advertise- 
ments of  7  Eliz.,"  then,  is  this : — 

The  first  Prayer  Book,  of  2  Ed.  VL,  1549, 
retained  the  old  Popish  vestments,  by  some 
rubrics  quite  at  the  end  of  it,  which  may 
therefore  easily  be  overlooked.  His  second 
Prayer  Book,  of  1552,  was  much  more  Protes- 
tant ;  abolished  the  mass,  materially  altered 
the  prayer  of  consecration  at  the  communion, 
and  substituted  the  surplice  for  the  other 
vestments  in  all  ministrations  of  the  clergy. 
That  was  all  repealed  under  Mary ;  so  that 
when  Elizabeth's  reign  began,  on  November 
17,  1559,  the  old  vestments  were  again  in 
use.  Her  Act  of  Uniformity,  1  Eliz.  c.  2, 
brought  back  Edward's  second  Prayer  Book, 
with  a  few  small  alterations,  but  with  this 
also,  that  section  13  of  the  Act  "provided 
that  such  ornaments  of  the  Church,  and  of 
the  ministers  thereof,  shall  be  retained  and 


10 


ADVEKTISEMENTS 


be  in  use  as  was  in  this  Cliurcli  of  England 
by  the  authority  of  Parliament  in  the  2nd 
year  (i.e.  first  Prayer  Book)  of  Ed.  VI,  until 
other  order  shall  be  taken  by  the  authority 
of  the  Queen  with  the  advice  of  her  Com- 
missioners appointed  under  the  Great  Seal 
for  matters  ecclesiastical,  or  of  the  Metro- 
politan of  this  realm,"  which  plainly,  though 
inaccurately,  meant  the  Primate  of  all 
England  (Parker),  and  was  so  taken  by 
everybody.  1'he  vestments,  being  then  in 
full  use,  were  literally  retainable  until  such 
other  order  should  abolish  them ;  and  then 
the  Cro\vn  could  restore  them  no  more  with- 
out another  Act. 

Elizabeth  issued  some  Injunctions  in  1559, 
which  have  been  held  not  to  relate  to  vest- 
ments in  church,  and  did  not  profess  to  be 
the  "  taking  of  other  order  "  under  that  Act. 
Nor  did  a  letter  of  hers  under  the  Great  Seal 
on  January  7, 1561,  N.S.,  to  the  Archbishop 
and  other  commissioners  say  anything  about 
vestments,  but  it  did  profess  to  be  taking 
order  under  the  Act ;  or  rather,  giving  them 
the  authority  to  do  so  as  the  Act  provided. 
For  the  order  was  only  to  be  taken  by  the 
Queen's  authority,  not  by  the  Queen  herself. 
In  January  1565,  N.S.,  she  wrote  another 
letter  to  the  Metropolitan,  which  is  recited 
in  the  Preface  to  the  Advertisements  as  the 
authority  for  making  them,  and  is  given  in 
full  in  a  pamphlet  on  this  subject  by  a 
modern  namesake  of  Archbishop  Parker,  who 
maintains  that  the  commissioners  were 
exceeding  their  authority  in  meddling  with 
the  vestments  at  all  under  that  letter  which 
they  cite  for  it.  The  Privy  Council  has 
twice  decided  otherwise,  and  Lord  Selbome 
wrote  a  pamphlet  also  on  the  same  side, 
which  Mr.  Parker  professes  to  refute.  The 
xitle-page,  as  quoted  by  him  from  one  of  the 
early  copies  (which  varied  a  little),  was — 
"Advertisements,  partly  for  due  order  in 
the  public  administration  of  common  prayers 
and  using  the  holy  sacraments,  and  partly 
for  the  apparel  of  all  persons  ecclesiastical 
by  virtue  of  the  Queen's  Letters  command- 
ing the  same,  Jan.  25 : "  other  copies  add, 
"  1564:  (-5,  N.S.),  anno  7  Eliz.  R."  But  they 
were  not  issued  or  enforced  till  May  1566, 
though  they  had  been  evidently  discussed  with 
the  Queen  between  those  times,  and  there  is 
no  doubt  that  Parker  wanted  to  get  her 
ex  post  facto  sanction  to  them  besides 
her  previous  authority;  and  there  is  no 
surviving  evidence  that  he  did  get  it,  for  she 
always  liked  to  reserve  an  excuse  for  repudi- 
ation in  case  things  turned  out  ill.  It  is 
doubly  immaterial  now  whether  he  did  get 
either  a  verbal  or  a  written  order  to  issue 
them.  For  in  the  very  letter  of  March  28, 
1565,  which  the  objectors  rely  on,  he  said  to 
Cecil,  "The  Queen  will  needs  have  me  assay 
with  mine  own  authority  what  I  can  do  for 


ADVEETISEMENTS 

order ; "  which  proves  that  he  had  some  kind' 
of  instruction  from  her  to  proceed,  though 
she  would  not  write  anything  more,  so  far  as 
is  known ;  nor  did  the  Act  require  any  more. 
Doubtless  she  could  have  stopped  the  issue 
of  the  orders  even  then,  and  Parker  would 
never  have  dared  to  issue  them  against  her 
will :  but  she  plainly  did  the  contrary  some- 
how. And  so  they  were  issued,  after  being 
"  agreed  upon  and  subscribed  by  M.  Cantuar, 
E.  London,"  and  others,  "  Commissioners  in 
causes  ecclesiastical." 

It  is  curious  that  the  Advertisements, 
besides  the  subscriptions  to  be  made  by 
persons  admitted  to  any  office,  are  39,  like 
the  Articles.  Those  about  vestments  pre- 
scribe a  comely  surplice  with  sleeves  in  all 
ministrations,  except  that  the  ministrants  at 
the  communion  in  cathedrals  are  also  t& 
wear  copes.  They  immediately  began  to 
be  enforced  by  the  bishops,  according  to 
abundant  evidence  of  many  bishops  and 
archdeacons  and  writers  during  the  remainder 
of  Elizabeth's  reign  and  afterwards ;  and  it 
is  not  denied  that  the  other  vestments 
speedily  disappeared  all  over  the  kingdom, 
and  never  reappeared  until  a  few  years  ago. 
And  what  is  still  more  remarkable  as  proving 
why  they  disappeared,  the  Book  of  Advertise- 
ments, or  Admonitiones,  as  the  Latin  canons 
call  them,  was  recognised  within  5  years  by 
a  Convocation  in  some  (abortive)  canons  of 
1571,  and  by  the  duly  confirmed  canon  of 
1603-4,  and  by  some  more  of  1640,  which 
were  confirmed  by  the  king,  but  set  aside  by 
the  Parliament,  and  undoubtedly  were  ultra 
vires  and  illegal;  but  still  they  were  the 
solemn  utterances  of  the  Convocations  of 
both  provinces,  and  therefore  good  evidence 
of  the  universal  recognition  of  the  Advertise- 
ments. Nor  is  there  any  evidence  that  they 
were  disputed  by  any  one  worth  naming 
during  the  whole  reign  of  Elizabeth,  whether 
puritanically  or  papistically  inclined.  The 
first  person  of  note  who  did  so  afterwards 
was  Bishop  Cosin,  who  after  that  confessed 
that  he  had  forgotten  the  terms  of  the  Act 
of  Uniformity ;  and  his  was  only  a  second- 
hand opinion,  for  he  was  not  bom  till  nearly 
30  years  after  the  Advertisements.  It  is 
odd  that  an  older  Cosin,  who  was  Dean  of 
Arches  in  Elizabeth's  reign,  wrote  in  support 
of  them,  in  answer  to  an  anonymous  and 
what  he  called  a  factious  libel,  in  1584.  His 
answer  was  anonymous  too,  but  is  well 
known  to  be  his. 

It  will  be  better  to  finish  the  subject  of 
the  vestments  here  than  to  postpone  the  rest> 
of  it  till  the  ornaments  rubric  of  1662,  which 
is  substantially  in  the  same  words  as  one 
which  was  printed  in  the  Elizabethan 
Prayer  Books  without  any  real  authority, 
being  a  copy  of  the  first  part  only  of  that 
clause  of  the  Act  already  quoted  above— i.e. 


ADVEETISEMENTS 

it  omitted  the  words  "  until  other  order,"  &c. 
It  is  impossible  to  ascertain  now  how  it  came 
to  be  so  printed  and  to  be  kept  there 
illegally  and  absurdly  long  after  every  vest- 
ment in  the  kingdom  had  disappeared.  An 
equally  illegal  thing  was  done  early  in  the 
next  reign  in  the  issuing  of  the  Jacobean 
Prayer  Book  in  1604  by  royal  authority, 
professedly  under  the  powers  of  the  Eliza- 
bethan Act  of  Uniformity,  which  authorised 
nothing  of  the  kind.  And  it  contained  a 
still  more  illegal  rubric,  omitting  the  im- 
portant word  "  retained"  before  "  be  in  use," 
and  so  did  undoubtedly  profess  to  restore  the 
old  vestments.  But  they  nevertheless  were 
not  restored,  even  in  the  royal  chapels,  for 
by  that  time  the  real  dispute  was  not  between 
surplices  and  other  vestments,  but  between 
surplices  and  none. 

Then  came,  in  1661-2,  the  first  lawful  new 
Prayer  Book  after  Elizabeth's.  There  are 
the  usual  historical  doubts  now  about  the 
exact  stages  of  the  various  alterations;  of 
which  it  IS  enough  to  say  that  the  more 
Protestant  majority  of  the  bishops  to  whom 
it  was  referred  after  the  Savoy  Conference, 
would  not  let  Cosin  and  Sanoroft,  who  were 
of  the  High  Church  party,  have  their  way 
in  many  things ;  and  in  particular,  the 
Puritans  at  the  Conference  having  objected 
that  the  Jacobean  rubric  "  seemed  to  bring 
back  the  vestments,"  as  it  certainly  did,  the 
old  word  "  retained "  was  afterwards  rein- 
stated by  the  bishops,  so  as  to  bring  back 
nothing  that  had  then  vanished  for  a  century, 
both  actually  and  legally.  Although  Cosin, 
at  different  periods  of  his  life,  thus  wrote 
different  opinions  about  the  Advertisements 
which  were  made  before  he  was  born,  he 
never  attempted,  either  before  or  after  1662, 
to  revive  the  vestments  in  his  o^vn  cathedral ; 
nor  did  Bancroft,  or  anybody  else.  And 
Bishop  Sparrow,  one  of  the  revisers  of  1661, 
is  said  to  have  written  in  his  own  Prayer 
Book  that  priests  were  to  wear  a  surplice  in 
ordinary  ministrations,  and  a  cope  at  com- 
munion in  cathedral  and  collegiate  churches. 
He  also  edited  a  book  containing  the  Ad- 
vertisements, Injunctions,  Articles,  and 
Canons  of  1603. 

Another  legal  principle  involves  the  same 
conclusion.  Nothing  but  a  distinct  repeal 
of  an  existing  law  does  repeal  it,  if  the  old 
and  new  can  be  reconciled.  So  far  from  the 
rubric  of  1662  being  a  clear  repeal  of  the 
Advertisements  and  Canons  about  surplices 
and  vestments,  it  is  rather  the  contrary,  by 
reason  of  the  word  "  retained,"  which  in- 
volves the  inquiry  of  what  was  then  in 
existence  legally  and  actually.  This  is  the 
substance  of  the  Purchas  and  Eidsdale  judg- 
ments on  this  point  in  the  Privy  Council 
(L.  11.  3  P.  C.  634,  and  2  Prob.  300).  (See 
Ornaments).    [G.] 


ADV  EETISEMENTS 


11 


IT.  It  seems  desirable  here  briefly  to  state 
the  reasons  why  a  large  number  of  persons 
are  unable  to  concurin  the  legal  decisions  re- 
ferred to  in  the  foregoing  account,  and  are 
of  opinion  that  the  Advertisements  in  no' 
wise  cancel  or  override  the  direction  of  the 
"  Ornaments  llubric."  The  2nth  and  26th 
clauses  of  the  Act  of  Uniformity  passed  m 
the  1st  year  of  the  reign  of  Elizabeth  are  as 
follows : 

"  [S.  xiii.]  Provided  always  and  be  it  en- 
acted that  such  ornaments  of  the  Church 
and  of  the  ministers  thereof  shall  be  re- 
tained and  be  used,  as  was  in  this  Church 
of  England  by  authority  of  Parliament  in 
the  2nd  year  of  the  reign  of  King  Edward 
VI.,  until  other  order  shall  be  therein  taken 
by  the  authority  of  the  Queen's  Majesty, 
with  the  advice  of  her  Commissioners  ap- 
pointed and  authorised  under  the  great  seal 
of  England  for  causes  ecclesiastical,  or  of  the 
Metropolitan  of  this  realm ;  [xxvi]  and  also 
if  there  shall  happen  any  contempt  or  ir- 
reverence to  be  used  in  the  Ceremonies  or 
Eites  of  the  Church  by  the  misusing  of  the 
orders  appointed  in  this  book,  the  Queen's 
Majesty  may,  by  the  like  advice  of  the  said 
Commissioners  or  Metropolitan  ordain  and 
publish  such  further  Ceremonies  or  Bites  as 
may  be  most  for  the  advancement  of  God's 
glory,  the  edifying  of  this  Church,  and  the 
due  lleverence  of  its  Holy  Mysteries  and 
Sacraments." 

The  Ornaments  Rubric  in  Elizabeth's 
Prayer  Book,  1559,  and  subsequent  books 
till  1661,  ran  thus :  "  And  here  is  to  be 
noted  that  the  Minister  at  the  time  of  the 
Communion  and  at  all  other  times  in  his 
ministration  shall  use  such  ornaments  in 
the  Church  as  were  in  use  by  authority  of 
Parliament  in  the  2nd  year  of  the  reign  of 
King  Edward  the  VI.  according  to  the  Act 
of  Parliament." 

Thus  the  rubric  was  based  upon  the 
Act,  and  was  clearly  to  remain  valid 
until  the  Act  itself  should  be  repealed  by 
"  other  order  "  being  taken.  The  question 
is, was  such  "other  order"  taken  in  the 
Advertisements  by  authority  of  the  Queen's 
Majesty? 

In  1561  'the  Queen  certainly  did  take 
"  other  order  "or  "  further  order  "  within 
the  meaning  of  the  Act,  for  she  issued  a 
letter  to  her  commissioners,  the  Archbishop 
of  Canterbury,  the  Bishop  of  London,  and 
others,  directing  them  to  revise  the  Lection- 
ary,  to  relbrm  the  disorders  of  chancels, 
and  to  add  to  the  adornment  of  them  by 
causing  the  tables  of  commandments  to  be 
set  up  at  the  east  end.  It  is  to  be  ob- 
served that  in  the  preamble  of  this  letter  a 
direct  reference  is  made  to  the  clauses  in 
the  Act  of  Uniformity  cited  above,  in  the 
following  terms :  "  letting  you  to  understand 


12 


ADVERTISEMENTS 


that  where  it  is  provided  by  Act  of  Parlia- 
ment liolden  in  the  1st  year  of  our  reign 
that  whensoever  we  shall  see  cause  to  take 
further  order  in  any  rite  or  ceremony,"  &c., 
"  we  therefore  ....  have  thought  good  to 
require  you  our  said  Commissioners,"  &c. 

The  letter  is  formally  signed  and  dated 
(January  22, 1561);  it  is  preserved  amongst 
the  State  papers  of  Elizabeth's  reign;  one 
copy  of  it  exists  in  Archbishop  Parker's 
Eegister  at  Lambeth  (fol.  215);  another 
amongst  his  papers  at  Corpus  Christi 
College,  Cambridge.  Lastly,  the  Kalendars 
of  lessons  were  altered  in  all  the  Books  of 
Common  Prayer  as  the  result  of  the  revision 
made  by  the  Commissioners. 

If  we  turn  to  the  letter  of  the  Queen 
addressed  to  the  archbishop  in  January, 
1564  (=1565  N.S.),  which  ultimately  led  to 
the  issue  of  the  Advertisements,  we  find  that 
it  is  devoid  of  all  those  characteristics  which 
marked  the  former  letter  as  a  "taking  of 
other  order  "  under  the  Act,  (i.)  it  contains 
no  reference  whatever  to  that  Act ;  it  com- 
plains of  the  varieties  and  novelties  both  in 
opinion,  and  in  rites  and  ceremonies  which 
disturbed  the  peace  of  the  Church ;  and  it 
enjoins  the  archbishop  to  confer  with  his 
suffragans  on  the  subject,  to  enquire  what 
the  varieties  are,  to  deal  with  each  case  as 
it  arises  "  according  to  the  order  and  ap- 
pointment of  such  laws  and  ordinances  as 
are  provided  by  Act  of  Parliament,"  and 
not  to  admit  any  to  the  cure  of  souls  but 
those  who  will  promise  to  "  observe,  keep 
and  maintain  such  order  and  uniformity  in 
aU  the  external  rites  and  ceremonies  both 
for  the  Church  and  for  their  awo.  persons  as 
by  laws,  good  usages,  and  orders  are  already 
allowed  provided  and  established." 

In  short  the  letter  requires  the  Metro- 
politan and  his  suffragans  not  to  make  any 
new  law  or  order,  but  to  take  care  that  all 
existing  laws  and  orders  should  be  in  future 
obeyed.  In  accordance  with  these  instruc- 
tions, the  bishops  met  and  enquired  into  the 
"  novelties  "  complained  of,  which,  judging 
from  a  document  containing  the  substance 
of  the  returns  obtained,  were  certainly  not 
excesses  in  ritual,  but  defects ;  e.g.  some 
celebrated  Holy  Communion  with  "  surpless 
and  copes,  some  with  surpless  alone,  others 
with  none."  Some  baptised  in  a  fount, 
others  in  a  bason,  some  in  a  surpless,  others 
without."  On  March  3,  1565,  the  arch- 
bishop sends  to  Secretary  Cecil  a  rough 
copy  of  some  articles  (which  were  in  a 
great  measure  repetitions  of  some  orders  and 
injunctions  which  had  been  agreed  upon 
amongst  the  bishops  in  1561),  and  on 
March  8  a  fair  copy  of  the  same,  with  a 
request  that  he  would  present  them  to  the 
Queen  and  get  her  to  authorise  them. 
After    two  more    letters   (March  24,  and 


ADVERTISEMENTS 

April  7)  urging  the  same  request,  but 
without  success,  the  subject  was  dropped  for 
a  whole  year.  It  was  then  revived  March 
12,  1566,  by  a  letter  from  Parker  to  Cecil 
lamenting  his  want  of  success  in  enforcing 
discipline,  and  expressing  his  great  regret 
that  the  Queen  will  not  give  the  weight  of 
her  authority  to  the  rules  or  Advertisements 
drawn  up  a  year  ago.  On  March  28  he 
writes  to  say  that  he  has  just  printed  the 
Advertisements,  that  he  has  weeded  out  of 
the  book  everything  which  he  thinks  may 
have  "  stayed  it  from  the  Queen's  approba- 
tion," that  he  believes  there  is  nothincr  in  it 
against  any  law  of  the  realm,  and  that  as 
he  must  now  "assaye"  with  his  "own 
authority  "  what  he  can  "  do  for  order,"  he 
trusts  he  shall  not  now  be  hindered  in  his 
efforts.  Accordingly  the  Advertisements 
were  issued.  As  Parker  could  not  obtain 
the  formal  authorization  of  the  Queen,  he 
made  as  much  as  he  could  of  the  Queen's 
letter  as  the  originating  cause  of  the  Adver- 
tisments — ^both  in  the  title  and  the  preface. 
In  the  title  they  are  designated  "  Advertise- 
ments partly  for  due  order  in  the  public  ad- 
ministration of  common  prayer  and  using  the 
Holy  Sacraments,  and  partly  for  the  apparel 
of  all  persons  ecclesiastical,  by  virtue  of  the 
Queen's  Majesties  letters  commanding  the 
same  "  (i.e.  "the  same  "  due  order  in  adminis- 
tration, &c.,_not  the  same  Advertisements, 
for  the  letter  commands  no  Advertisements, 
but  does  require  the  enforcement  of  due 
order, — in  the  preface  reference  is  made  to 
the  Queen's  letter  desiring  that  some  orders 
might  be  taken  to  reform  and  repress  such 
varieties  as  were  contrary  to  existing  laws, 
usages  and  ordinances."  Thus  neither  in 
the  letter  nor  in  the  Advertisements  is  there 
any  reference  to  "  taking  other  order  "  under 
the  Act  of  Uniformity. 

(ii.)  The  Advertisements  are  not  given 
under  the  royal  signet,  but  are  merely 
signed  by  the  archbishop  and  five  other 
bishops.  (iii.)  In  the  copies  sent  by 
Parker  to  the  Dean  of  Docking  and  other 
commissaries  of  his  "  peculiars  "  they  are 
merely  termed  "  orders  agreed  upon  by  me 
and  other  of  my  brethren  of  my  province 
of  Canterbury."  (iv.)  No  copy  of  the  Ad- 
vertisements exists  amongst  the  State 
Papers,  or  in  Parker's  Register,  (v.)  In 
the  Visitation  Articles  of  Archbishop  Parker, 
and  other  bishops  of  his  province,  they  are 
referred  to,  if  at  all,  as  the  Advertisements 
"  set  forth  by  public  authority,"  or  simply 
"  the  book  called  the  Advertisements,"  and 
are  thus  carefully  distinguished  from  the 
"Queen's  Majesty's  Injunctions  of  1559," 
which  are  also  referred  to.  (vi.)  In  the 
Visitation  Articles  of  the  Archbishop  of 
York  in  1571,  they  are  not  referred  to  at 
all,  as  they  would  surely  have  been  had  they 


ADVERTISEMENTS 

■been  understood  to  be  issued  by  royal  au- 
thority. 

It  seems  to  many  impossible  in  tbe  face 
of  this  evidence  to  conclude  that  the  Queen 
took  "  other  order  "  or  "  further  order  "  in  the 
Advertisements  -within  the  meaning  of  the 
Act  of  Uniformity  (clauses  xxv.  and  xxvi.) 

It  only  remains  to  be  observed  that  when 
she  did  take  "other  order"  in  1561,  and 
directed  a  new  Lectionary  to  be  prepared, 
every  Prayer  Book  was  altered  accordingly, 
whereas  after  the  issue  of  the  Advertise- 
ments no  change  was  made  whatever,  not 
even  in  the  Ornaments  Rubric  which  is 
supposed  to  be  affected  by  them.  The 
simple  explanation  of  this  appears  to  be 
that  it  was  not  necessary  to  alter  or  revise 
the  rubric  because  the  Advertisements 
in  no^vise  clashed  with  it.  Looking  at 
the  contents  of  the  Advertisements  we  find 
that  they  are  mainly  a  repetition  of  the 
Queen's  injunctions  issued  in  1559,  and 
their  aim  is  to  enforce  those  which  had 
been  most  grossly  neglected,  allowing  a 
modified  observance  of  others  to  which 
exact  obedience  could  not  be  enforced.  E.g. 
the  injunctions  had  directed  that  rectors 
should  preach  in  their  churches  "one 
sermon  every  month  at  the  least,"  and 
subsequently  "  once  in  every  quarter  at  the 
least ; "  the  Advertisements  order  that "  if  he 
be  able  he  shall  preach  in  his  own  person 
every  three  months  or  else  shall  preach  by 
another."  The  rubric  of  1552  required  that 
in  cathedral  and  collegiate  churches  the 
clergy  should  communicate  "every  Sunday 
at  the  least,"  the  Advertisements  require 
the  Holy  Communion  to  be  ministered 
in  such  churches  "on  the  1st  or  2nd 
Sunday  of  every  month  at  the  least,"  so 
that  the  dean  and  other  clergy  should  all 
receive  four  times  in  the  year  at  least." 

In  respect  of  the  vesture  of  the  clergy 
the  Advertisements  direct  that  in  cathedral 
and  collegiate  churches  in  the  ministration 
of  Holy  Communion  the  celebrant  and 
assistant  clergy  should  wear  copes,  that  is  to 
say,  the  rubric  of  Edward  VI.'s  first  Prayer 
Book  is  left  substantially  unchanged  which 
prescribed  a  white  alb  plain  with  a 
vestment  or  cope,  the  surplice  being  very 
similar  to  the  alb  and  the  cope  to  the 
vestment.  For  all  other  clergy  at  aU 
times  of  ministration  in  the  church  the 
Advertisements  directed  the  use  of  the 
surplice.  On  the  analogy  of  the  other 
directions,  about  the  times  of  preaching,  &c., 
cited  above,  it  seems  only  reasonable  to 
interpret  this  to  mean  that  the  surplice 
should  suffice,  and  to  believe  that  here  as 
elsewhere  the  Advertisements  state  the 
minimum  which  would  be  tolerated,  not 
the  maximum  whicb  was  not  to  be  ex- 
ceeded. 


ADVOCATES 


13 


Such  a  spirit  of  negligence  and  slovenli- 
ness prevailed  that  the  bishops  could  barely 
get  the  minimum  of  ritual  observed,  and 
it  is  no  wouder  therefore  that  all  vest- 
ments except  the  surplice  disappeared. 
But  it  is  obvious  that  there  was  no  need 
to  alter  or  remove  the  Ornaments  Eubric. 
The  Advertisements  did  not  abrogate  it,  and 
therefore  it  remained  unaltered  in  all  ex- 
isting and  subsequent  editions  of  the  Prayer 
Book  until  the  Revision  of  1661,  when  the 
words  "such  ornaments,  &c.,  shall  be  re- 
tained and  be  in  use "  were  substituted 
"  for  the  minister  shall  use  such  orna- 
ments ; "  the  object  of  this  change  being,  as 
appears  from  a  note  in  the  margin  of  San- 
croft's  fair  copy,  to  bring  the  Rubric  into 
exact  conformity  with  the  language  of  the 
clause  XXV.  in  the  Act  of  Uniformity  of 
1559.  (Cardwell's  Documentary  Annals ; 
Archbishop  Parker's  Register,  Lambeth; 
Stephens'  Notes  on  Book  of  Common 
Prayer  ;  Introduction  to  llevision  of  Booh 
of  GomTnon  Prayer,  by  James  Parker,  Hon. 
M.A.  Oxon. ;  Did  Queen  Mizdbeth  take 
other  order  in  the  Advertisements  of  1566  ? 
the  same  ;  lAfe  of  Archhvihop  Parker,  by 
W.  P.  Hook,  b.D.)    [W.  R.  W.  S.] 

ADVOCATE,  (1)  the  word  used  in  one 
passage  in  our  Bibles,  1  John  ii.  1,  as  a 
translation  of  the  Greek  TrapdKXrjTos,  which 
signifies  literally  "  one  called  to  the  side  of 
another,"  and  so  secondarily  "  one  who  aids 
another,"  by  exhorting,  or  comforting  him. 
In  St.  John  xiv.  16,  and  xv.  26,  the  word 
is  rendered  "  Comforter."  (See  Paraclete.') 
(2)  The  word  advocate  thus  came  to  imply 
one  who  prays  or  intercedes  for  another. 
Christ  is  called  our  advocate,  1  John  ii.  1 ; 
and  in  the  Prayer  Book  very  frequently  the 
term  is  applied  to  our  Lord ;  as  in  the  prayer 
for  the  Clergy,  Church  Militant,  &c.  &c. 

ADVOCATES  are  mentioned  in  the  96th, 
131st,  and  133rd  Canons,  as  regular  members 
of  the  Ecclesiastical  Courts.  The  pleaders, 
or  superior  practitioners,  in  all  the  English 
and  Irish  Church  Courts  were  so  called.  In 
Loudon,  A.D.  1567,  they  formed  a  corporation, 
or  college,  called  Doctors'  Commons ;  because 
they  must  be  Doctors  of  Law,  and  they  for- 
merly lived  together  in  a  collegiate  manner, 
■with  a  common  table,  &c.  The  candidate 
Advocates  obtained  a  fiat  from  the  archbishop 
of  Canterbury,  and  were  admitted  by  the 
judge  to  practise.  But  there  are  no  longer 
special  Advocates  in  those  courts,  since  the 
Acts  establishing  the  Probate  and  Divorce 
Court  in  1857.  The  pleaders  in  the  supreme 
courts  in  Scotland,  and  generally  throughout 
Europe,  are  called  Advocates.  The  insti- 
tution of  the  order  is  very  ancient.  About 
the  time  of  the  emperor  Alexander  Severus 
(see  Butler's  Life  of  VEopitaT)  three  ranks 
of  legal  practitioners  were  established ;  the 


14: 


ADVOWSON 


orators,  who  were  the  pleaders ;  the  advo- 
cates, who  instructed  the  orators  in  points  of 
law ;  and  the  cognitores,  or  procuraiores, 
who  discharged  much  the  same  office  as 
proctors  or  attorneys  now.  The  first  order 
gradually  merged  into  the  second. 

ADVOWSON  (Advocatto)  is  the  right  of 
patronage  to  a  church,  or  an  ecclesiastical 
benefice,  and  he  who  has  the  right  of  advow- 
Eon  is  called  the  patron  of  the  church.  For 
when  lords  of  manors  first  built  churches 
upon  their  own  demesnes,  and  appointed  the 
tithes  of  those  manors  to  be  paid  to  the  offici- 
ating ministers,  which  before  were  given  to  the 
clergy  in  common,  the  lord,  who  thus  built 
a  church  and  endowed  it  with  glebe  or  land, 
had  of  common  right  a  power  annexed  of 
nominating  such  minister  as  he  pleased 
(provided  he  were  canonically  qualified)  to 
officiate  in  that  church,  of  which  he  was  the 
founder,  endower,  maintainer,  or,  in  one 
word,  the  patron  (patronus,  and  sometimes 
advocatus). 

Advowsons  are  of  two  sorts,  advowsons 
appendant,  and  advowsons  in  gross.  "When 
annexed  to  a  manor  or  land,  so  as  to  pass 
with  them,  they  are  appendant ;  for  so  long 
as  the  church  continues  annexed  to  the 
possession  of  the  manor,  as  some  have  done 
from  the  foundation  of  the  church  to  this 
day,  the  patronage  or  presentation  belongs 
to  the  person  in  possession  of  the  manor  or 
land.  But  when  the  property  of  the  ad- 
yowson  has  been  once  separated  from  that 
of  the  manor  by  legal  conveyance,  it  is  called 
an  advowson  in  gross,  or  at  large,  and  exists 
as  a  personal  right  in  the  person  of  its  owner, 
independent  of  his  manor  or  land.  Advow- 
sons are  also  either  presentative,  coUative, 
donative,  or  elective.  An  advowson  presen- 
tative is  where  the  patron  has  a  right  to 
present  the  parson  to  the  bishop  or  ordinary  to 
be  instituted  and  inducted,  if  he  finds  him 
canonically  qualified.  An  advowson  collative 
is  where  the  bishop  is  both  patron  and 
ordinary.  An  advowson  donative  is  where 
the  king,  or  any  subject  by  his  licence, 
founds  a  church  or  chapel,  and  ordains  that 
it  shall  be  merely  in  the  gift  or  disposal  of 
the  patron;  subject  to  his  visitation  only, 
and  not  to  that  of  the  ordinary ;  and  vested 
absolutely  in  the  clerk  by  the  patron's  deed 
of  donation,  without  presentation,  institution, 
or  induction. 

As  to  presentations  to  advowsons :  where 
,there  are  divers  patrons,  joint-tenants,  or 
tenants  in  common,  and  they  vary  in  their 
.presentment,  the  ordinary  is  not  bound  to 
admit  any  of  their  clerks;  and  if  the  six 
months  elapse  within  which  time  they  are 
to  present,  he  may  present  by  the  lapse; 
but  he  may  not  present  within  the  six 
months ;  for  if  he  do,  they  may  agree  and 
bring  a  quare  impedit   against  him,  and 


■     ADVOWSON 

remove  his  clerk.  Where  the  patrons  are 
co-parceners,  the  eldest  sister,  or  her  as- 
signee, is  entitled  to  present :  and  then  at 
the  next  avoidance,  the  next  sister  shall 
present,  and  so  by  turns  one  sister  after 
another,  till  all  the  sisters,  or  their  heirs, 
have  presented,  and  then  the  eldest  sister 
shall  begin  again,  except  they  agree  to 
present  together,  or  by  composition  to 
present  in  some  other  manner.  But  if  the 
eldest  presents  together  with  another  of  her 
sisters,  and  the  other  sisters  every  one  of 
them  in  their  own  name,  or  together,  the 
ordinary  is  not  bound  to  receive  any  of  their 
clerks,  but  may  suffer  the  church  to  lapse. 
But  in  this  case,  before  the  bishop  can  take 
advantage  of  the  lapse,  he  must  direct  a  writ 
to  inquire  the  right  of  patronage.  Where  an 
advowson  is  mortgaged,  the  mortgagor  alone 
shall  present,  when  the  church  becomes 
vacant,  and  the  mortgagee  can  derive  no 
advantage  from  the  presentation  in  reduction 
of  his  debt.  If  a  woman  has  an  advowson, 
or  part  of  an  advowson,  to  her  and  her  heirs, 
and  marries,  the  husband  may  not  only 
present  jointly  with  his  wife,  during  the 
coverture,  but  also  after  her  death  the  right 
of  presenting  during  his  life  is  lodged  in  him, 
as  tenant  by  courtesy,  if  he  has  children 
by  her.  And  even  though  the  wife  dies 
without  having  had  issue  by  her  husband,  so 
that  he  is  not  tenant  by  courtesy,  and  the 
church  remains  vacant  at  her  death,  yet  the 
husband  shall  present  to  the  void  turn ;  and 
if  in  such  case  he  does  not  present,  his 
executor  may.  If  a  man,  seized  of  an 
advowson,  takes  a  wife,  and  dies,  the  heir 
shall  have  two  presentations,  and  the  wife 
the  third,  even  though  her  husband  may 
have  granted  away  the  third  turn.  Or,  if  a 
manor,  to  which  an  advowson  is  appendant, 
descends  to  the  heir,  and  he  assigns  dower  to 
his  mother  of  the  third  part  of  the  manor, 
with  the  appurtenances,  she  is  entitled  to 
the  presentation  of  the  third  part  of  the 
advowson  ;  the  right  of  presentation  being 
a  chose  in  action  v/hich  is  not  assignable. 
If  an  advowson  is  sold  when  the  church  is 
vacant,  it  is  decided  that  the  grantee  is 
not  entitled  to  the  next  presentation.  If, 
during  the  vacancy  of  a  church,  the  patron 
die,  his  executor,  or  personal  representa- 
tive, is  entitled  to  that  presentation,  unless 
it  be  a  douative  benefice,  in  which  case 
the  right  of  donation  descends  to  the 
heir.  But  if  the  incumbent  of  a  church 
be  also  seized  in  fee  of  the  advowson  and  die, 
his  heir,  and  not  his  executors,  shall  present, 
because  it  did  not  fall  vacant  in  his  life. 

As  to  the  manner  in  which  advowsons 
descend,  it  has  been  determined,  that 
advowsons  in  gross  cannot  descend  from  the 
brother  to  the  sister  of  the  entire  blood,  but 
they  shall  descend  to  the  brother  of  the  half 


iELPHBAH 

•blood,  unless  the  first  had  presented  to  it  in 
his  lifetime,  and  then  it  shall  descend  to  the 
■sister,  she  Ijeing  the  next  heir  of  the  entire 
tlood.  (See  Lapse,  and  Phillimore's  Jicc. 
Law,  "Advowson.") 

iELPHBAH.    (See  Alphege.) 

MO'H^.  (Klavis,  ages.)  The  name 
given  by  some  of  the  Gnostic  heretics  to  the 
«pirituai  beings,  whom  they  supposed  to 
iave  emanated  from  the  Supreme  i)eity,  and 
to  be  like  Him  eternal — whence  the  name. 
(See  Valentinians.') 

AERIANS.  A  small  sect  founded  by 
Aerius,  a  presbyter  of  Sebaste,  in  the  lesser 
Armenia,  about  a.d.  355.  St.  Augustine 
{Hxr.  liii.)  tells  us  that  Aerius,  the  author  of 
this  heresy,  was  mortified  at  not  attaining  the 
episcopate ;  and  having  fallen  into  the  heresy 
or  Arius,  and  having  been  led  into  many 
strange  notions  by  impatience  of  the  control 
of  the  Church,  he  taught  among  other  things, 
,that  no  difl'erence  ought  to  be  recognised 
between  a  bishop  and  a  presbyter ;  where- 
as, until  then,  even  all  sectaries  had  acknow- 
ledged the  episcopate  as  a  superior  order,  and 
had  been  careful  at  their  outset  to  oljtain 
episcopal  ordination  for  their  ministers.  (Dr. 
Newman's  Fleury,  bk.  xix.  36.)  „Thus 
Aerius  revenged  himself  upon  the  dignity  to 
which  he  had  unsuccessfully  aspired ;  and  he 
has  left  his  history  and  his  character  to 
future  ages,  as  an  argument  almost  as  forcible 
as  direct  reasoning  and  evidence,  of  the  apo- 
stolical ordinance  of  the  episcopate. 

AETIANS.  A  sect  of  heretics  in  the 
fourth  century.  They  had  this  name  from 
their  chief  person  Aetius  of  Antioch.  This 
man  applied  himself  to  the  sciences  at 
Antioch,  Tarsus,  and  for  a  short  time  at 
Alexandria,  and  acquainted  himself  with  the 
medical  art,  as,  well  as  with  theology.  As 
all  his  instructors  were  of  Arian  sentiment, 
he  also  applied  his  talents  and  his  dexterity 
in  debate  to  the  vindication  of  the  Arian 
doctrine,  which  he  carried  to  the  extreme 
conclusion  that  the  Second  and  Third  Persons 
in  the  Holy  Trinity  were  utterly  unlike  the 
First  Person.  He  was  made  a  deacon  at  An- 
tioch in  350 :  but  deposed  and  banished  in 
the  reign  of  Constantino.  Julian  recalled 
him  and  gave  him  a  bishopric  (Stubbb' 
Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  306-307).  Besides 
the  Arian  [doctrines,  the  Aetians  main- 
tained that  faith  without  works  was  suffi- 
cient to  salvation,  and  that  no  sin  would  be 
imputed  to  the  faithful.  Aetius  asserted 
that  God  had  revealed  to  him,  what  He  had 
concealed  from  the  Apostles.  His  followers 
were  commonly  called  Eunomians,  from  his 
pupil  Eunomius,  or  Anomceans,  from  their 
doctrine  that  the  Second  and  Third  Persons  in 
the  Trinity  were  unlike  (avofioioi)  the  first. 
• — Epiph.  Essres.  Ixxvi.  c.  11 ;  Socrat.  E.  E. 
di.  35  ;..  Sozomen,  E,  E.  iii.  15,  iv.  12. 


AFFINITY 


15 


AFFINITY.  PLclationship  arising  from 
marriage.  The  wife's  blood  relatives  are 
related  by  affinity  to  the  husband,  and  his 
blood  relatives  are  so  to  her.  Affinity  no 
less  than  consanguinity  (see  Consanguinity) 
has  been  deemed  in  Christian  countries  a 
bar  to  marriage  between  relatives.  The 
prohibitions,,  which  place  both  sexes  on  one 
and  the  same  footing,  forbidding  marriage  on 
either  side  to  those  related  by  consanguinity 
or  affinity  within  the  first  or  second  degree, 
are  fully  and  clearly  exhibited  in  the  Table 
annexed  to  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer. 
It  is  described  as  "  A  Table  of  Kindred  and 
Affinity  wherein  whosoever  are  related  are 
forbidden  in  Scripture  and  our  Laws  to  marry 
together."  It  is  these  prohibitions  which 
are  referred  to  in  the  solemn  charge  addressed 
by  the  priest  to  the  parties  in  the  Office  for  the 
Solemnization  of  Matrimony:  "Be  ye  well 
assured  that  so  many  as  are  coupled  together 
otherwise  than  God's  Word  doth  allow,  are 
not  joined  together  by  God,  neither  is  their 
matrimony  lawful." 

I.  "God's  Word"  is  chiefly  to  be  found 
in  Leviticus  xviii.  6-18,  and  xx.  11-21.  It 
is  plain  that  the  restrictions  laid  down  in 
those  chapters  are  not  intended  to  bind  the 
Jews  only.  The  Canaanites  are  condemned 
in  severe  terms  (xviii.  24-30 ;  xx.  22,  23), 
and  doomed  to  extermination  for  breach  of 
these  laws ;  and  the  Canaanites  were  never 
under  the  Levitical  law,  which  was  not  even 
given  when  the  Canaanities  were  here 
reckoned  tlaus  guilty.  The  laws  laid  down 
belong  evidently  to  the  common  moral  law 
binding  on  all  mankind. 

The  ground  on  which  these  marriages  are 
forbidden  is  declared  in  verse  C,  "None  of 
you  shall  approach  to  any  that  is  near  of  kin 
to  him  "  :  literally  "  flesh  of  his  flesh,"  or  as 
margin,  "  remainder  of  flesh,"  (sheer  of  his 
basar).  The  following  verses  down  to  verse 
18  contain  instances  in  illustration  of  this 
principle.  The  list  is  not  exhaustive ;  it  is 
intended  only  to  give  examples  sufficient  in 
number  and  nature  to  make  the  legislator's 
meaning  clear.  Various  examples  are  set 
down,  all  the  relations  specified  being 
regarded  as  "  near  of  kin."  It  cannot  be 
maintained  that  only  those  marriages  are 
intended  to  be  interdicted  which  are  so  in 
actual  words  ;  for  marriage  with  a  daughter 
or  sister  or  niece  by  blood  is  not  named.  Nor 
can  it  be  asserted  that  consanguinity  only  is 
recognized  as  a  bar,  for  of  the  thirteen  persons 
instanced  as  "  near  of  kin,"  no  less  than  seven 
are  made  relations  only  through  marriage. 
To  take  one  instance  only :  in  Lev.  xviii. 
14,  the  uncle's  wife  is  forbidden  because 
"  she  is  thine  aunt "  ;  where  it  is  plain  that 
affinity  is  counted  a  bar  just  as  if  it  were 
consanguinity.  In  truth  the  prohibitions 
are  unintelligible  unless  we  regard  them,  in 


16 


AFFIKITY 


the  way  the  Church  has  always  done,  as 
samples  and  illustrations  of  a  principle. 
The  Table  of  Prohibited  Degrees  simply 
exhibits  in  all  its  details  the  principles  laid 
down  in  general  terms  by  Leviticus,  and 
there  exemplified  in  some  details  only ;  and 
assumes  that  what  is  forbidden  to  the  man 
is  by  implication  forbidden  to  the  woman 
also. 

But  it  is  urged  that  in  verse  18  we  read, 
"Neither  shalt  thou  take  a.  wife  to  her 
sister  to  vex  lier,  beside  the  other  in  her 
lifetime";  and  that  the  legislator  by  pro- 
hibiting marriage  with  the  wife's  sister  in 
her  lifetime  tacitly  allows  it  after  the  wife's 
death.  This  is,  however,  a  very  obscure 
verse  on  any  interpretation.  Even  if  we 
admit  that  "sister"  in  it  means  sister  by 
blood,  and  that  Moses  merely  meant  to 
interdict  the  polygamous  Jews  from  that 
which  their  forefather  Jacob  did — having 
two  sisters  at  once  as  wives — it  is  not  clear 
what  is  intended  by  the  words,  "to  vex 
her."  Why  should  the  first  wife  be  more 
vexed  that  her  husband  should  marry  her 
sister  than  any  other  woman,  if  a  second 
wife  there  must  be  ?  Family  arrangements 
amongst  the  Jews  would  rather  point  to  this 
as  desirable,  if  to  marry  another  sister  were 
lawful  at  all.  But  in  truth  there  is  reason 
to  think  that  the  words  "  a  wife  to  her  sister  " 
mean  simply  "a  woman  to  her  sister," 
"  one  woman  to  another,"  or  "  one  wife  to 
another,"  as  the  margin  gives  it.  (See  Bp. 
Wordsworth's  Commentary,  in  loco.)  Thus 
the  purport  of  the  verse  would  be  to  put  a 
check  on  polygamy,  prohibiting  it  in  the 
interests  of  domestic  peace  when  it  would 
"vex"  the  first  wife,  who  would  always 
according  to  Oriental  ideas  have  superior 
estimation  over  those  subsequently  taken. 
Dr.  Kalisch  however,  a  very  high  authority 
about  Hebrew  language  and  law,  regards  the 
text  here  as  corrupted  by  interpolation. 
(See  Historical  and  Critical  Commentary 
on  Leviticus,  pp.  363-365,  and  395-397 ; 
Longman  &  Co.,  1872).  He  believes  that 
the  words  originally  ran  simply,  "  Thou 
shalt  not  take  a  wife  to  her  sister,"  and 
supports  his  view  by  referring  to  the  Koran, 
which  borrows  its  legislation  in  many  such 
matters  from  Moses.  The  corresponding 
passage  in  the  Koran  says  plainly,  "You 
are  also  forbidden  to  take  to  wife  two 
bisters."  {Koran,  iv.  27.)  It  is  true  that 
the  Babbinical  Jews  unanimously  regard 
the  verse  as  permitting  marriage  with  the 
deceased  wife's  sister ;  but  it  is  to  be  feared 
that  here  as  elsewhere  determination  to 
reject  the  Christian  view  of  the  question  has 
prejudiced  their  opinion  on  the  text.  It  is 
significant  that  the  Karaite  Jews  have 
always  held  marriage  with  a  deceased  wife's 
sister  to  be  forbidden  by  the  law  of  Moses ; 


AFFINITY 

and  the  Karaites,  who  have  been  not  inaptly 
termed  the  Protestants  of  Judaism,  pride 
themselves  on  strict  adherence  to  the  letter 
of  the  written  law,  rejecting  the  whole  mass 
of  oral  traditions  and  expositions  with  which 
the  Jewish  schools  had  overlaid  the  Word 
of  God,  and  often  made  it  of  none  effect. 
(See  Herzog,  Encyclopddie,  article  Earlier.) 
It  must  also  be  observed  in  general  that  the 
clear  drift  of  the  whole  chapter  ought  not  to 
be  set  aside  on  the  authority  of  an  obscure 
and  doubtful  verse ;  a  verse  probably  corrupt, 
and  which,  if  sound,  admits  of  no  less  than 
fourteen  varying  interpretations.  If  marriage 
with  a  deceased  wife's  sister  is  sanctioned 
here,  then,  as  Kalisch  says,  "  unity  of  prin- 
ciple and  harmony  of  detail  are  destroyed  in 
the  Levitical  lists  of  forbidden  degrees."  We 
may  add,  as  not  without  significance,  that 
the  Vatican  MS.  of  the  Septaagint  contains 
in  Deut.  xxvii.  23  a  special  malediction 
against  the  connexion  with  a  wife's  sister, 
where  the  A.  V.  speaks  of  the  mother-in- 
law  only.  If  this  be  an  interpolation,  it  is 
certainly  a  very  early  one,  and  reflects  at 
any  rate  the  mind  of  the  age  in  which  it  was 
made.  It  is  more  probable,  however,  that 
the  Greek  translator  added  the  clause  refer- 
ring to  the  sister-in-law  by  way  of  bringing 
out  more  fully  the  sense  of  the  Hebrew,  for 
the  word  (cotheneth)  really  means  any 
female  relative  by  marriage. 

Difficulties  as  regards  prohibitions  based  on 
affinity  have  been  raised  in  consequence  of 
what  is  known  as  the  law  of  the  levirate  laid 
down,  Deut.  xxv.  5-10;  comp.  St.  Matt, 
xxii.  23-28.  It  is  to  be  observed  in  con- 
nexion with  this  subject  that  mamage  with 
the  wife  of  a  deceased  brother  was  not, 
properly  speaking,  permitted  by  the  Jewish 
law  at  all.  On  the  contrary,  it  was  strictly 
forbidden  (see  Levit.  xviii.  16,  xx.  21) ;  and 
denounced  too  as  a  defilement  and  an  abomi- 
nation. On  the  other  hand,  in  Deut.  xxv. 
5-10,  it  is  enjoined  as  a  sacred  duty,  under 
certain  circumstances  only,  when  a  brother 
died  childless.  The  general  result  is  surely 
clear  enough.  The  alliance  in  question, 
which,  be  it  observed,  is  precisely  similar  so 
far  as  afBnity  is  concerned  to  a  marriage 
between  a  widower  and  his  late  wife's  sister, 
was  sternly  prohibited  as  a  rule  by  the 
general  moral  law.  But  to  protect  those 
agrarian  rights  which  were  at  the  basis  of 
the  Hebrew  system  and  institutions  as 
regards  property,  and  to  prevent  the  extinc- 
tion of  a  family  in  Israel,  this  marriage  was 
— not  permitted — but  rendered  imperative 
under  special  circumstances  by  the  law  of 
God.  And  the  ignominious  penalties 
annexed  to  violation  of  this  obligation  (see 
Deut.  xxv,  9,  10 ;  Ruth  iv.  11)  show  how 
abhorrent  the  connexion  was  to  Jewish, 
customs.    Where  the  special  circumstances 


AFFINITY 

and  the  local  and  national  emergencies 
have  no  place,  this,  like  other  connexions 
within  the  Prohibited  Degrees,  must  be 
deemed  to  be  according  to  tlie  law  of  Moses 
incestuous  and  prohibited. 

II.  The  Law  of  the  Christian  Church.  No 
very  eai'ly  references  to  the  subject  can  be 
found,  probably  because  the  ancient  Roman 
law  was  very  nearly  coincident  with  the 
Mosaic.  But,  a.d.  305,  the  Council  of 
Elvira  (Can.  Ixi.)  imposed  excommunication 
for  five  years  on  the  man  who  should  marry 
his  wife's  sister ;  and  for  life  on  him  who 
should  marry  his  step-daughter  (Can.  Ixvi.) 
This  is  the  first  known  ecclesiastical  legis- 
lation about  affinity.  The  Council  of  Isleo- 
CiBsarea  (a.d.  314)  completes  the  prohibition 
on  the  woman's  side.  The  Apostolical  Canons 
(Can.  ix.)  declare  marriages  with  two  sisters 
or  a  niece  to  disqualify  for  ordination.  St. 
Basil,  in  a  letter  to  Diodorus  (a.d.  373), 
declares  connexion  with  two  sisters  to  be 
imholy  and  "  no  marriage,"  and  refers  to  the 
Mosaic  Law.  A  Council  at  Rome  under 
Iimocent  I.  (a.d.  402)  forbids  marriage  with 
a  wife's  sister,  an  uncle's  wife,  or  first 
cousin ;  that  of  A^de  (a.d.  506),  brands  as 
incestuous  union  with  a  brother's  widow, 
wife's  sister,  step-mother,  step-daughter, 
cousin,  or  any  kinswoman.  Like  decrees 
were  formulated  by  many  later  Councils,  in 
which  the  Levitical  degrees  are  frequently 
quoted  or  referred  to.  The  Council  of 
Mayence  (a.d.  813)  forbids  marriage  to  those 
related  in  the  fourth  degree,  and  in  later 
times  the  restrictions  became  more  multi- 
phed  and  rigid,  till  at  length  marriage  was 
interdicted  within  seven  degrees.  (Comp. 
Decretum  Qratiani,  P.  ii.  causa  35.)  This 
rigour  coidd  not  be  long  retained,  and  at  the 
fourth  Lateran  Council  (a.d.  1215),  under 
Innocent  III.,  prohibition  was  limited  to 
four  degrees;  and  these  were  frequently 
relaxed  by  Papal  "  Dispensations."  These 
concessions  were  granted  on  the  assumption 
that  the  Pope  possesses  the  power  to  suspend 
not  only  the  Church  Canons,  but  even  the 
Scriptural  ordinances.  About  the  fact  that 
relationships  up  to  the  second  degree  at  any 
rate,  whether  of  afiinity  or  consanguinity, 
are  barriers  to  marriage,  there  has  been 
universal  consent  amongst  all  councils, 
churches,  and  doctors. 

III.  The  Law  of  the  English  Church  and 
Eealm  has  always  been  coincident  with  that 
of  Christendom  generally.  The  words  of  the 
late  Lord  Chancellor  Hatherley  in  a  speech 
delivered  in  St.  James's  Hall  on  Thursday, 
Feb.  26th,  1880,  (reported  in  the  Ovardian 
newspaper  of  March  3rd,  1880)  are  weighty. 
"In  England,  he  unhesitatingly  declared, 
that  there  had  been  no  change  in  the  law 
since  the  baptism  of  Ethelbert."  In  the 
reign  of  Hen.  VIII.  and  Edw.  VI.  various 


AFFINITY 


17 


statutes  were  passed  for  taking  away  "  dis- 
pensations," and  invalidating  all  marriages 
not  within  the  Levitical  degrees.  In  these 
(see  25th  Hen.  YIIL  c.  22;  28th  Hen 
VIIL  c.  7;  2nd  and  3rd  Edw.  VJ.  c.  23), 
marriages  within  those  degrees  are  already 
and  repeatedly  recognised  as  "  prohibited  by 
the  laws  of  God."  The  Table  of  Prohibited 
Degrees  was  set  forth  in  1563  only  in  order  to 
make  clear  and  easily  inteUigible  the  relation- 
ships to  which  the  statutes  referred  as  obstacles 
to  matrimony.  This  table  is  referred  to  by 
Canon  99  of  1603  as  follows :  "  No  person 
shall  marry  within  the  degrees  prohibited 
by  the  laws  of  God,  and  expressed  in  a  table 
set  forth  by  authority  in  the  year  of  our  Lord 
1563,  and  all  marriages  so  made  and  con- 
tracted shall  be  adjudged  incestuous  and 
unlawful,  and  consequently  shall  be  dissolved 
as  void  from  the  beginning,  and  the  parties 
so  married  shall  by  course  of  law  be  separated. 
And  the  aforesaid  table  shall  be  in  every 
church  publicly  set  up  at  the  charge  of  the 
parish." 

The  status  of  marriage  could  only,  up  to 
1857,  be  determined  by  the  ecclesiastical 
courts :  and  persons  contracting  unlawful 
unions  availed  themselves  of  the  loopholes 
left  by  the  requirements  of  the  Canon  Law, 
namely,  that  the  parties  should  be  separated 
and  their  marriage  dissolved  by  sentence  of 
court.  They  procured  the  commencement  of 
a  mock  suit  against  themselves  for  incest,  and 
this  barred  the  way  of  a  real  prosecution,  since 
two  proceedings  were  not  permitted  to  go  on 
at  the  same  time  for  the  same  offence.  The 
suit  was  protracted  by  technicalities  until 
the  death  of  one  of  the  parties,  after  which 
the  civil  courts  would  not  permit  the  vahdity 
of  the  marriage  to  be  called  in  question.  In 
order  to  put  a  stop  to  these  evasions  of  the 
law,  the  Act  5  &  6  Will.  IV.  c.  54,  commonly 
known  as  Lord  Lyndhurst's  Act,  was  passed 
in  1835.  It  enacted  that  marriage  within 
the  Prohibited  Degrees  shordd  be,  not  merely 
voidable  by  sentence  of  court  as  hitherto, 
but  "  absolutely  null  and  void  to  all  intents 
and  purposes  whatsoever."  It  is  therefore 
altogether  false  to  assert  that  marriage  with 
a  deceased  wife's  sister  was  legal  before  1835, 
and  made  illegal  first  by  Lord  Lyndhurst's 
Act.  That  Act  only  cured  certain  defects 
in  procedure  by  means  of  which  the  law 
had  been  sometimes  broken,  but  made  no 
alteration  whatever  in  the  law  of  marriage 
itself.  Marriage  with  a  wife's  sister  was 
before  1835,  as  it  still  is,  just  as  illegal  as 
marriage  with  a  man's  oivn  sister  or  own 
niece.  In  no  case  of  incest,  however  revolt- 
ing, prior  to  1835  could  the  illegality  be- 
come legally  determined  and  the  parties  be 
separated  without  sentence  of  court.  Since 
1835  such  marriages  are  void  ipso  facto. 
That  is  all  the  difference. 


18 


AFFINITY 


IV.  The  moral  and  social  basis  of  the  Pro- 
hibited Degrees.  Man  and  wife  are  "one 
flesh"  (aen.  ii.  24;  St.  Matt.  xix.  5,  6; 
Eph.  V.  31).  It  is  on  this  principle  that  the 
Levitical  Degrees  proceed :  e.g.  Lev.  xviii.  8 
prescribes,  "  The  nakedness  of  thy  father's 
■wife  thou  shalt  not  uncover;  it  is  thy 
father's  nakedness."  The  "  nakedness  "  of 
the  husband  is  uncovered  in  that  of  the  wife 
because  the  two  are  "one  flesh"  by  their 
marriage.  Thus  the  principle  is  carefully 
insisted  on  in  primeval  times,  under  the 
Mosaic  law,  by  the  Saviour  Himself,  by  the 
Apostle  of  the  Gentile  Churches.  It  is  an 
obvious  and  necessary  consequence  that  a 
man  cannot  marry  connexions  by  affinity 
where  he  cannot  marry  the  like  connexions 
by  blood,  for  the  former  are  "  part  of  the 
flesh  "  (Lev.  xviii.  7 ;  xx.  14)  of  her  who 
has  become  one  flesh  with  him. 

Any  infringement  of  this  principle  is 
plainly  fatal  to  the  whole  idea  of  marriage 
as  set  forth  in  the  Bible  throughout.  Nor  is 
it  possible  to  abandon  the  principle  in  one 
case  and  to  retain  it  in  others.  Either 
affinity  is  a  bar  to  marriage  between  persons 
so  related  or  it  is  not.  If  it  be  a  bar,  it 
must  be  wrong  to  marry  two  sisters ;  if  it 
be  not  a  bar,  it  is  impossible  to  justify  the 
existing  prohibitions  against  unions  with  the 
wife's  niece,  the  step-daughter,  or  the  wife's 
kinswomen  in  general.  The  proposal  to 
legalize  marriage  with  a  deceased  wife's 
sister  strikes  thus  at  the  whole  foundation 
of  English  domestic  life. 

These  restrictions  on  marriage  are  not  to 
be  regarded  as  arbitrary.  Their  reason  and 
purpose  are  to  be  seen  in  the  necessity  for 
protecting  the  purity  of  family  life.  Mar- 
riage involves  an  intimacy  with  the  wife's 
relatives  which  would  not  be  innocent  and 
safe  unless  the  impossibility  of  marriage 
with  them  were  clearly  understood.  The 
prohibitions  are  intended  to  throw  over  the 
wife's  family  precisely  the  same  safeguards  as 
are  by  consanguinity  provided  for  the  man's 
own  family ;  and  relaxation  of  them  must 
involve,  and  has  wherever  tried  been  found 
to  involve,  dangers  and  embarrassments  from 
which  the  present  state  of  the  law  exempts  us. 
The  results  on  family  life  of  the  innovations 
in  this  matter  which  have  been  tolerated  in 
Eepublican  America  are  described  in  a  letter 
addressed  to  the  late  Lord  Hatherley,  and 
published  by  him,  from  which  copious 
extracts  will  be  found  in  the  Church 
Quarterly  Review  for  January,  1883,  p.  424. 
In  Protestant  Germany  one  relaxation  after 
another  has  been  admitted  imder  dispensa- 
tion from  the  State  until  marriage  with  an 
own  brother's  or  sister's  child  has  become  so 
common  that  an  orphan  niece  cannot  live 
with  her  own  uncle.  In  Eepublican  France 
the  ancient  law  was  swept  away  in  1792, 


AFFUSION 

and  such  were  the  family  troubles  that 
followed,  especially  in  relation  to  the  wife's 
sister,  tliat  the  Code  Napoleon  in  1802  in- 
terdicted particularly  marriage  with  that 
relative ;  and  the  Conseil  d'etat  came  to 
resolutions  to  that  effect,  without  admitting 
dispensation  under  any  circumstances,  on 
the  ground  of  the  family  disorders,  the 
immoraUty,  and  the  applications  for  divorce, 
to  which  the  liberty  to  contract  these 
marriages  had  given  occasion.  It  is  obvious, 
when  the  subject  is  reasoned  out,  that  the 
Prohibited  Degrees  as  laid  down  in  Leviticus, 
and  applied  by  parity  of  reasoning  in  the 
Table  of  the  Church  of  England,  form  a 
security  for  the  peace  and  purity  of  domestic 
life  which  must  be  preserved,  if  at  all,  in  its 
integrity.  To  legalize  marriage  -with  a 
deceased  wife's  sister  cannot  possibly  remain 
a  solitary  innovation.  We  shall  have 
abandoned  the  strong  ground  of  the  Divine 
Laws  as  interpreted  by  the  Christian  Church, 
and  have  taken  the  first  step  in  a  revolution 
of  the  whole  of  our  domestic  and  much  of 
our  social  life.     [T.  B.  B.] 

APFIEMATION.  By  various  modern 
Acts  of  Parliament,  beginning  with  9 
Geo.  IV.  c.  32,  first  Quakers,  and  at  last, 
by  a  succession  of  Acts,  everybody  who 
says  he  has  a  conscientious  objection  to 
taking  an  oath,  or  is  objected  to  as  in- 
competent, is  allowed  to  make  an  afiir- 
mation  instead  in  giving  evidence,  and 
a  false  affirmation  is  made  equivalent  to 
perjury.  "Declarations,"  as  they  are 
called,  have  also  been  substituted  for  the 
old  official  Promissory  oaths  of  church- 
wardens and  many  other  public  offices ;  but 
oaths  of  a  very  simple  kind  are  substituted 
for  the  old  oaths  of  Allegiance  and  Su- 
premacy and  Abjuration  by  31  &  32  Vict, 
c.  72,  amending  therein  the  Clerical  Sub- 
scription Act  of  1865,  only  three  years 
before.  Jews  used  to  be  excluded  from 
Parliament,  not  expressly,  but  because  one 
of  the  oaths  concluded  with  the  words  "  on 
the  true  faith  of  a  Christian,"  which  dis- 
appeared under  that  Act  of  1868,  and 
indeed  by  a  previous  one  of  1866,  with  a 
different  form  of  parliamentary  oath,  under 
which  all  persons  who  may  lawfully  affirm 
in  Courts  of  Justice  may  do  so  in  either 
House  of  Parliament.  It  was  held  in 
Clarhe  v.  Bradlaugh  (7  Q.  B.  D.  38)  that  a 
parliamentary  affirmation  by  an  avowed 
Atheist  was  not  within  that  Act,  even  with 
the  help  of  the  "  Evidence  Further  Amend- 
ment Acts  "  of  1869  and  1870.    [GJ 

AFFUSION.  The  pouring  of  the  water 
on  recipients  of  'Koly  Baptism.  Trine  im- 
mersion, or  affusion,  was  the  ancient  rule 
to  which  TertuUian  bears  witness.  (See 
Immersion.')  The  rubric  says,  if  they 
certify   that    the   child  is   weak,  it  shall 


AFRICA 

suffice  to  pour  water  upon  it  It  sKould 
here  be  noticed,  that  our  Church  doth  not 
direct  spriiiklinj;  or  aspersion,  but  affusion 
or  "  pourin;;  ot  water  "  upon  the  children  to 
be  baptized.  It  is  true  the  quantity  of 
water  to  be  used  is  nowhere  prescribed, 
.nor  is  it  necessary  that  it  should  bo;  but, 
however  the  quantity  be  lefc  to  the  minis- 
ter's discretion,  yet  it  must  be  understood 
to  determine  itself  thus  far;  first,  that  the 
action  be  such  as  is  properly  a  "  washing," 
to  malie  the  administration  correspond  with 
the  institution ;  and  this  wo  should  observe 
as  ministers  of  Christ  at  large;  secondly, 
that  the  action  be  such,  as  is  properly  a 
"  pouring  of  water,"  which  is  the  rubrical 
direction  to  express  that  washing  at  all 
times  when  "dipping"  is  not  practised; 
and  this  we  are  bound  to  observe  as  minis- 
ters of  the  Church  of  England  in  par- 
ticular ;  taking  it  always  for  granted  that 
there  is  a  reason  for  whatever  is  prescribed 
in  a,  rubric,  and  such  an  one  as  is  not  to 
be  contradicted  by  our  private  practice, 
or  rejected  for  the  sake  of  any  modes 
or  customs  brought  in  we  know  not 
how. 

And  we  should  the  rather  keep  to  this 
rule  of  affusion,  because  we  have  in  a  man- 
ner lost  that  more  primitive  way  of  bap- 
.tizing  by  immersion.  Custom  having  "  cer- 
tified" in  general,  that  it  is  the  opinion 
.and  judgment  of  all,  who  bring  their  chil- 
dren to  the  font,  that  they  ai'e  "  too  weak 
to  endure  dipping." 

Either  of  these  modes  of  administering 
baptism  is  sufiicient.  For  it  is  not  in  this 
spiritual  wasbing,  as  it  is  in  the  bodily, 
where,  if  tlie  bath  be  not  large  enough  to 
a-eceive  the  whole  body,  some  parts  may  be 
foul  when  the  rest  are  cleansed.  The  soul 
is  cleansed  alter  anothir  manner ;  a  little 
water  can  cleanse  the  believer,  as  well  as  a 
whole  river.  The  old  fashion  was  to  dip  or 
.sprinkle  the  person  "  thrice,"  to  signify  the 
jnystery  ot"  the  Trinity,  and  also  to  sym- 
bolize the  three  days  during  which  our  Lord 
lay  buried.  The  Church  so  appointed  then 
'liecause  of  some  heretics  that  denied  the 
Trinity  ;  upon  the  same  ground,  afterwards, 
it  was  appointed  to  do  it  but  once  (signi- 
fying the  unity  of  sub.stance  in  theTVinity), 
Jest  we  should  seem  to  agree  with  the 
ieretics  that  did  it  thrice.  This  baptizing 
is  to  be  at  the  "  font." — Bfi.  Sparrow. 

AFEICA.  CHURCH  IN.  The  first  Chris- 
.tian  Missions  to  Africa  were  sent  by  the 
Eoman  Church.  Incredible  toils  and  hard- 
,  ships  were  undergone  by  these  missionaries, 
who  were  of  the  Capuchin  <  Irder;  but  they 
were  enabled  to  bring  some  of  the  savage 
natives  to  a  knowledge  of  Christ,  and  at 
.last,  in  1652,  the  cruel  Queen  of  Matamba, 
^nna  Zingla,  allowed  herself  and  her  people 


AGAP^ 


19 


to  be  baptized.  (Soames'  Mosheim,  Stubbs' 
Edition,  iii.  201.) 

In  the  16th  and  17th  centuries  the  Portu- 
guese sent  out  missionaries,  who  afterwards 
made  several  establishments  and  penetrated 
a  considerable  distance  into  the  interior. 
The  Dutch,  Danes,  and  English  made 
attempts  to  follow  the  Portuguese  in  their 
enterprise ;  but  it  was  not  till  the  formation 
of  the  African  Association  in  1788  that 
much  was  done  in  this  direction.  In  1815 
the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  which  had  been 
alternately  in  the  hands  of  the  Dutch  and 
English,  was  confinned  to  the  latter,  and 
since  that  time  there  have  been  continual 
explorations  and  constant  missionary  work 
carried  on.  There  are  at  present  in  Africa, 
and  the  adjacent  islands,  thirteen  English 
dioceses,  besides  a  missionary  bishopric 
(Cape  Palmas),  founded  by  the  Church  of 
the  United  States.  These  are  (in  order  of 
their  formation)  Cape  Town,  Sierra  Leone, 
Graham's  Town,  Mauritius,  St.  Helena, 
Central  Africa,  Bloemfontein,  Niger,  Ma- 
ritzburg,  Zululand,  St.  John's,  Madagas- 
car, Pretoria.  The  bishopric  of  Maritz- 
burg  was  founded  in  consequence  of  the 
deposition  of  the  Bishop  of  Natal.  This 
bishop.  Dr.  Colenso,  had  written  a  book 
impugning  the  veracity  of  Holy  Scripture, 
in  consequence  of  which  a  united  letter 
from  all  the  bishops  of  England  and  Ire- 
land, with  the  exception  of  Drs.  Thirlwall 
(St.  David's),  Fitzgerald  (Killaloe),  and 
Griffen  (Limerick),  was  sent  to  him,  re- 
questing him  to  resign  his  see.  On  his 
refusal,  he  was  tried  before  a  provincial 
synod  at  Cape  Town,  on  the  charges  of 
denying  the  Atonement,  the  Inspiration  of 
Scripture,  the  Divinity  of  our  Lord,  &c., 
and  found  guilty.  He  was  therefore  for- 
mally deposed  on  Nov.  27,  1863.  The 
deposition  was  subsequently  declared  null 
and  void  by  the  Queen  in  Council,  on  the 
ground  that  the  Metropolitan  of  Cape  Town 
had  no  authority  over  the  Bishop  of  Natal. 
In  1866  a  sentence  of  excommunication 
was  published  against  Dr.  Colenso  by  the 
Bishop  of  Cape  Town,  and  a  new  bishop  was 
consecrated  to  take  charge  of  the  diocese. 
As  by  law  Dr.  Colenso  was  not  deposed, 
the  new  bishop  was  styled  Bishop  of  Pieter- 
maritzburg. 

For  an  account  of  the  ancient  North 
African  Churches,  see  Bingham,  A7it.  bk. 
ix.  0.2.    [H.] 

AGAPjij.  Love  feasts,  or  feasts  of 
charity,  among  the  early  Christians,  were 
usually  celebrated  in  connexion  with  the 
Lord's  Supper,  but  not  as  a  necessary  part 
of  it.  The  name  is  derived  from  the  Greek 
word  ayairr],  which  signifies  love  or  charity. 
In  the  earliest  accounts  which  have  come 
down  to  us,  we  find  that   the  bishop  or 

c  2 


20 


AGAPJa 


presbyter  presided  at  these  feasts.  Before 
eating,  the  guests  washed  their  hands,  and 
a  public  prayer  was  offered  up.  A  portion 
of  Scripture  was  then  read,  and  the  presi- 
dent proposed  some  questions  upon  it,  which 
were  answered  by  the  persons  present. 
After  this,  any  accounts  which  had  been 
received  respecting  the  affairs  of  other 
Churches  were  recited ;  for,  at  that  time, 
such  accounts  were  regularly  transmitted 
from  one  community  to  another,  by  means 
of  which  all  Christians  became  acquainted 
with  the  history  and  condition  of  the  whole 
body,  and  were  thus  enabled  to  sympathise 
with,  and  in  many  cases  to  assist,  each  other. 
Letters  from  bishops  and  other  eminent 
members  of  the  Church,  together  with  the 
Acts  of  the  Martyrs,  were  also  recited  on 
this  occasion;  and  hymns  or  psalms  were 
sung.  At  the  close  of  the  feast,  money  was 
also  collected  for  the  benefit  of  widows  and 
orphans,  the  poor,  prisoners,  and  persons 
who  had  suffered  ship\vreck.  Before  the 
meeting  broke  up,  all  the  members  of  the 
Church  embraced  each  other,  in  token  of 
mutual  brotherly  love,  and  the  whole  cere- 
mony was  concluded  with  prayer. 

As  the  number  of  Christians  increased, 
various  deviations  from  the  original  prac- 
tice of  celebration  occurred,  which  called 
for  the  censures  of  the  governors  of  the 
Church.  In  consequence  of  these  irregu- 
larities, it  was  appointed  that  the  president 
should  deliver  to  each  guest  his  portion 
separately,  and  that  the  larger  portions 
should  be  distributed  among  the  presbyters, 
deacons,  and  other  officers  of  the  Church. 
It  is  imcertain  whether  the  "  love-feast "  was 
held  before  or  after  Holy  Communion,  but 
the  language  in  1  Cor.  xi.  seems  rather  to 
imply  the  former. 

While  the  Church  was  exposed  to  per- 
secution, these  feasts  were  not  only  con- 
ducted with  regularity  and  good  order,  but 
were  made  subservient  to  Christian  edifica- 
tion, and  to  the  promotion  of  brotherly 
love,  and  of  that  kind  of  concord  and  union 
whicb  was  specially  demanded  by  the  cir- 
cumstances of  the  times. 

At  first  these  feasts  were  held  in  private 
houses,  or  in  other  retired  places,  where 
Christians  met  for  religious  worship.  After 
the  erection  of  churches,  these  feasts  were 
held  within  their  walls ;  until"  abuses 
having  occurred  which  rendered  the  ob- 
servance inconsistent  with  the  sanctity  of 
such  places,  this  practice  was  forbidden. 
In  the  middle  of  the  fourth  century,  the 
Council  of  Laodicea  enacted  "  that  agapje 
should  not  be  celebrated  in  churches";  a 
prohibition  which  was  repeated  by  the 
Council  of  Carthage  in  the  year  391;  and 
was  afterwards  strictly  enjoined  during  the 
sixth  and  seventh  centuries.     By  the  efforts 


AGATHA 

of  Gfregory  of  Neo-Cajsarea,  St.  John  Chry- 
sostom,  and  others,  a  custom  was  generally 
established  of  holding  the  agapae  only  under 
trees,  or  some  other  shelter,  in  the  neigh- 
bourhood of  the  churches;  and  from  that 
time  the  clergy  and  other  principal  members 
of  the  Church  were  recommended  to  with- 
draw from  them  altogether. 

In  the  early  Church  it  was  usual  to  cele- 
brate agapaj  on  the  festivals  of  martyrs, 
agapae  natalitia;,  at  their  tombs ;  a  practice 
to  which  reference  is  made  in  the  epistle 
to  the  Church  of  Smyrna,  concerning  the 
martyrdom  of  Polycarp. 

These  feasts  were  sometimes  celebrated 
on  a  smaller  scale  at  marriages,  agapss  con- 
nuhiales,  and  funerals,  agapm  funerales. 

The  celebration  of  the  agapaj  was  fre- 
quently made  a  subject  of  calumny  and 
misrepresentation  by  the  enemies  of  the 
Christian  faith,  even  during  the  earliest 
and  best  ages  of  the  Chm-oh.  In  reply  to 
these  groundless  attacks,  the  conduct  of 
the  Christians  of  those  times  was  success- 
fully vindicated  by  Tertullian,  Minucius 
Felix,  Origen,  and  others.  But  real  dis- 
orders having  afterwards  arisen,  and  having 
proceeded  to  considerable  lengths,  it  became 
necessary  to  abolish  the  practice  altogether ; 
and  this  task  was  eventually  effected,  but 
not  without  the  application  of  various 
means,  and  only  after  a  considerable  lapse 
of  time. — Riddle,  from  August!  and  Stegel ; 
Bingham,  Ant.  bk.  xv.  c.  vii.  7. 

AGAPETiE  or  DILEOT^.  In  the 
third  century  it  became  a  custom  amongst 
some  of  the  clergy  and  monks  to  choose 
persons  of  the  other  sex,  devoted  like  them- 
selves to  a  life  of  celibacy,  with  whom 
they  lived  under  the  sanction  of  a  kind  of 
spiritual  nuptials,  still  maintaining  their 
chastity,  as  they  professed,  though  living, 
in  all  things  else,  as  freely  together  as 
married  persons.  These  women  were  called 
Agapetse,  Subintroductx,  ^vueiaaKTOi.  'J'his- 
practice,  however  pure  in  intention,  gave 
rise  to  the  utmost  scandal  in  the  Church ; 
and  those  who  had  adopted  it  were  con- 
demned severely,  both  by  the  individual 
authority  of  eminent  writers  and  bishops, 
especially  St.  Cyprian,  St.  Jerome,  and  St. 
John  Chrysostom,  and  by  the  decrees  of 
councils.  See  Dowell's  Bissertationes  Cy- 
prianicm.  Suicer,  Agapetm  and  Suneisaktoi. 

AGATHA.  Virgin  and  martyr.  A 
Sicilian  of  noble  birth,  who  suffered  in 
the  Deoian  persecution  (a.d.  253).  The 
legend  is  that  her  breast  was  cut  off  with 
iron  shears,  and  she  is  therefore  represented 
having  in  one  hand  the  palm,  and  in  the 
other  a  plate,  on  which  is  a  female  breast. 
In  some  representations  the  shears  are 
placed  in  her  hands.  She  is  commemorated 
in  the   English    black-letter   calendar    on 


AGE 

Feb.  5.  Her  name  was  originally  inserted 
in  the  calendar  by  Gregory  the  Great.   [H.] 

AGE,  THE  CANOiNICAL,  FOR  CONSE- 
CRATION AND  ORDINATION.  I.  The 
age  for  a  bishop  was  by  the  Apostolic  Consti- 
tutions laid  down  as  50  at  least  (Lib.  ii.  c.  1) ; 
but  afterwards  younger  men  were  admitted  to 
the  Episcopate,  though  never  under  30, 
except  in  very  rare  instances.  Thus  Athana- 
sius  was  probably  under  that  age  when  he 
was  made  bishop,  and  Remigius  was  ap- 
pointed to  the  see  of  Reims  when  only  22 
(a.d.  471).  A  canon  of  the  Greek  Church 
prescribes  50  as  the  age  for  a  bishop ;  but 
this  was  modified  by  an  edict  of  Justinian 
stating  that  he  should  be  above  30.  (Novell. 
cxxxvii.).  The  latter  is  the  age  required  in 
the  Church  of  England.  II.  The  Canon  Law 
defines  30  years  to  be  the  canonical  age  for 
the  priesthood,  which  age  is  also  prescribed 
by  the  old  Saxon  laws,  and  the  councils  of 
Neo-Cajsarea  (a.d.  314),  of  Aries  (a.d.  524), 
of  Toledo  (a.d.  633),  and  of  TruUo  (a.d. 
691).  The  Council  of  Trent  x^ermits  the 
ordination  of  deacons  at  23,  and  the  priests 
at  25  (a.d.  1563).  In  the  Greek  Church 
the  age  for  a  deacon  is  25,  that  which  was 
required  for  Levites  in  the  Jewish  Chm'ch, 
and  for  a  priest  30,  the  age  at  which  our 
Lord  commenced  his  ministry.  An  ancient 
canon  quoted  by  Maskell  declares  that  an 
exorcist,  reader,  or  porter,  should  be  over 
17  ;  an  acolyte  over  14 ;  a  sub-deacon  over 
17 ;  a  deacon  over  19  ;  a  priest  over  24 ;  and 
a  bishop  over  30. 

In  the  Ordinal  of  1552  the  age  for  the 
diaconate  was  21,  and  this  is  still  allowed 
in  the  American  and  Scottish  Church.  By 
Stat.  13  Eliz.  c.  12,  a  priest  was  required  to 
be  24  years  of  age.  This  was  followed  by 
the  34th  canon  of  1603,  and  by  the  rubric 
as  it  at  present  stands.     A  deacon  must  be 

23  unless  he  has  a  faculty — that  is  to  say, 
a  licence  or  dispensation  from  the  arch- 
bishop, which  may  be  given  to  persons  of 
extraordinary  ability.  4-i  Geo.  III.  c.  43, 
confirmed  the  right  hitherto  held  by  the 
primate  of  all  England  of  granting  such 
faculties,  but  enaitedfor  the  first  time,  that 
the  ordination  of  any  priest  or  deacon  under 

24  and  23  respectively  should  be  "merely 
void  in  law,"  and  be  incapable  of  holding  any 
preferment  by  virtue  thereof.  Archbishops 
Sharp  and  Ussher,  bishops  Bull  and  Jeremy 
Taylor,  were  each  ordained  before  the  pre- 
scribed age.    [H.] 

AGNES,  ST.,  is  commemorated  in  the 
English  black-letter  calendar  on  Jan.  21. 
She  was  a  Roman  maiden  of  patrician 
birth,  and  was  beheaded  at  the  age  of  13, 
during  the  Diocletian  persecution  (a.d.  306). 
St.  Jerome  says  that  in  his  time  the  fame  of 
St.  Agnes  was  spread  throughout  the  world ; 
St.  Augustine  refers  in  touching  terms  to 


AGNUS 


21 


her  memory,  on  "this  day":  thereby 
showing  the  antiquity  of  the  festivals.  St. 
Agnes  is  represented  as  holding  a  palm 
branch  in  one  hand,  and  caressing  a  lamb 
with  the  other.    [H.] 

AGNOETES  or  AGNOETJU.  (ayvota.) 
A  sect  of  Christian  heretics  about  the  yeai- 
370,  followers  of  Theojjhronius  the  Cappa- 
docian,  who  joined  himself  with  Eunomius ; 
they  called  in  question  the  omniscience  of 
God,  alleging  that  he  knew  not  things  past 
in  any  other  way  than  by  memory,  nor 
things  to  come  but  by  an  uncertain  pre- 
science.— Socrat.  Bist.  Eccles.  v.  24. 

In  the  6th  century  there  arose  another 
sect  of  the  same  name,  who  followed  The- 
misteus,  Deacon  of  Alexandria,  who,  it  is 
said,  believed  that  Christ  knew  not  when 
the  day  of  judgment  should  happen.  But 
it  appears  that  these  Agnoetas  merely 
denied  that  the  human  nature  of  Christ 
became  omniscient,  by  being  united  with  the 
divine  nature.  Nor  did  their  contemporaries 
in  general  understand  them  to  go  further. 
But  the  writers  of  the  middle  ages  repre- 
sent them  as  denying  altogether  the  omni- 
science of  Christ,  and  many  of  the  moderns, 
till  quite  recently,  had  similar  views  of  this 
sect. — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  431 ;  but 
see  also  Suicer,  Thes.  i.  v,  ayvorjTm,  and 
Blunt's  Dictionary  of  Sects,  &c.,  where  a  less 
favourable  view  is  taken  of  this  school.   [H.] 

AGNOSTICS.     (See  Positivists.) 

AGNUS  DEL  L  A  cake  of  wax,  used 
in  the  Roman  Church,  stamped  with  the 
figure  of  a  lamb  supporting  the  banner  of 
the  cross.  The  name  literally  signifies 
27(6  Lamb  of  God.  These  cakes,  being 
consecrated  by  the  Pope  with  great  solem- 
nity, and  distributed  among  the  people,  are 
supposed  to  possess  great  virtues.  Though 
the  efficacy  of  an  Agnus  Dei  has  not  been 
declared  by  Roman  councils,  the  belief  in  its 
virtue  has  been  strongly  and  universally 
established  in  the  Church  of  Rome.  Pope 
Urban  V.  sent  to  John  Palajologus,  emperor 
of  the  Greeks,  an  Agnus  folded  in  fine  paper, 
on  which  were  written  verses  explaining  all 
its  properties.  These  verses  declare  that  the 
Agnus  is  formed  of  balm  and  wax  mixed 
with  chrism,  and  that  being  consecrated  by 
mystical  words,  it  possesses  the  power  of 
removing  thunder  and  dispersing  storms,  of 
giving  to  women  with  child  an  easy  de- 
livery, of  preventing  shipwreck,  taking 
away  sin,  repelling  the  devil,  increasing 
riches,  and  of  securing  against  fire. 

II.  The  "  Agnus  Dei "  was  also  a  name 
given  to  an  anthem  sung  by  the  choir, 
while  the  priest  was  communicating.  The 
choir  sang  thrice:  "0  Lamb  of  God,  that 
takest  away  the  sins'  of  the  world,"  adding 
twice,  "  have  mercy  upon  us,"  and  the  third 
time,  "  grant  us  Thy  peace."     It  was  given  a 


22 


AISLE 


place  in  the  first  Liturgy  of  Edward  VI., 
but  has  since  neither  been  prescribed  nor 
forbidden.    [H.] 

AISLE.  (Ala.)  The  lateral  divisions  of 
a  church,  or  of  any  part  of  it,  as  nave, 
choir,  or  transept,  are  called  its  aisles.  (See 
Church.)  Where  there  is  but  one  aisle  to 
a  transept  it  is  always  at  the  east.  In 
foreign  churches  the  number  of  aisles  is 
freqiiently  two  on  each  side  of  the  nave 
and  choir ;  at  Cologne  there  are  three. 
This  arrangement  is  very  ancient,  since  it  is 
found  in  the  BasiUcas  of  St.  Jolm,  Lateran, 
and  St.  Paul,  at  Eome.  In  England  this 
was  very  seldom  the  original  plan.  All 
beyond  one  on  each  side  are  clearly  additions, 
as  at  Chichester,  Manchester,  St.  Michael's, 
Coventry,  Spalding,  and  several  _  other 
churches.  But  they  were  clearly  original  in 
the  Galilee  at  Durham,  as  there  are  four  rows 
of  Norman  arches,  and  all  the  substructure 
is  Norman,  though  later  windows  have  been 
built.  The  word  has  been  very  commonly 
also  applied  to  the  passages  or  alleys  between 
the  seats  of  the  congregation.  Thus  "  the 
middle  aisle  "  is  often  used.     [Gr.] 

AISE.  A  linen  napkin  to  cover  the 
chalice  used  in  Bishop  Andrewes'  chapel, 
and  in  Canterbury  cathedral,  before  the 
Eebellion.  See  Canterbury's  Boom,  1646, 
Neale's  Hist,  of  Puritans. 

ALASCANS.  A  name  given  to  those 
foreign  Protestants  in  England  in  the  16th 
century  who  embraced  the  extreme  Zwing- 
lian  tenets  adopted  by  John  Laski,  or  k 
Lasco,  a  Polish  ecclesiastic  of  noble  birth. 
He  had  been  first  shaken  in  his  opinion  by 
an  interview  with  Zwinglius  in  15ii4 ;  in 
1537  he  abandoned  his  preferments  and 
became  minister  to  a  congregation  in 
Embden,  the  capital  of  Priesland.  At 
the  invitation  of  Archbishop  Cranmer  he 
came  to  England  and  resided  with  him  at 
Lambeth  for  sis  months.  He  was  made 
superintendent  of  the  foreign  Churches, 
German,  Flemish,  French  and  Italian,  in 
London.  After  the  accession  of  Mary,  he 
and  some  of  his  followers  retreated  to 
Embden  again,  but  he  soon  deserted  them, 
and  after  a  short  sojourn  at  Frankfort  re- 
turned to  Poland,  where  he  died  in  1560. 

ALB,  or  ALBE.  A  white  linen  robe 
which  used  to  be  worn  by  clergy  at  cele- 
bration of  Holy  Communion,  and  other 
ofiSces.  The  58th  Canon  prescribes  a  surplice 
with  sleeves  to  be  worn  at  the  communion, 
as  well  as  at  other  services  ;  and  in  the 
rubric  after  the  communion  in  the  First 
P.  B.  of  Edw.  VI.,  regulating  the  Wednesday 
and  Friday  services,  the  priest  is  to  wear 
a  plain  alb  or  surplice.  This  however 
does  not  imply  that  the  surplice  and  alb 
were  the  same,  the  former  being  a  modifica- 
tion of  tie  latter.  The  intention  of  the  Canon 


ALBANENSES 

evidently  was  to  supersede  all  other  vest- 
ments by  the  surplice,  which  has  become 
the  usual  robe  for  the  clergy  in  the  Churcli 
of  England.  But  tlie  alb  was  an  under- 
robe,  and  another  vestment  was  used  upon 
it,  as  will  be  seen  from  the  rubric  in  the 
First  Prayer  Book  of  Kdw.  VI.  "  Upon  the 
day  and  the  time  appointed  for  tlie  minis- 
tration of  the  Holy  Communion  the  priest; 
that  shall  execute  the  l.oly  ministry,  shall 
put  upon  him  the  vesture  appointed  for 
that  administration,  that  is  to  say  a  white 
albe  plain,  with  a,  vestment  or  cope.  And 
when  there  be  m.any  priests  and  deacons, 
then  so  many  shall  be  ready  to  help  the 
priest  in  the  ministration,  as  shall  be 
requisite;  and  shall  have  upon  them  like- 
wise the  vestures  appointed  for  their 
ministry,  that  is  to  say  albes  with  tunicles," 
&c.  "  And  though  there  be  none  to  com- 
municate with  the  priest,  yet  these  days 
(after  the  Litany  ended)  the  priest  shall  put 
on  him  a  plain  albe  or  surplice,  with  a  cope, 
and  say  all  things  at  the  altar,"  &o.  (See 
Vestments,  Tunicle.) 

These  rubrics  are  referred  to  in  our  pre- 
sent Prayer  Book,  in  the  notice  preceding 
the  Morning  Prayer,  commonly  called  the 
"  Ornaments  Eubric."  (See  Accessories  of 
Service.)  Many  of  our  most  eminent  ritualists 
have  considered  the  rabric  of  Ed.  VI.  as  still 
binding  in  strictness  of  law.  But  the  Privy 
Council  has  several  times  decided  otherwise. 
(See  Vestment.) 

ALBAN  MARTYR.  Called  the  proto- 
martyr  of  Britain,  commemorated  in  the 
English  Calendar  on  June  17th.  He  was 
born  at  Verulam,  said  by  Bede  to  be  called 
in  the  English  tongue  Verlaoiacsestir  or  Va2t- 
lingacoestir,  a  Roman  station  near  the  modern 
St.  Alban's,  and  educated  at  Rome.  In  the 
Diocletian  persecution  (a.d.  303)  he  gave 
Amphibalus,  a  Christian  priest,  shelter,  hid 
him  from  the  persecutors,  and  was  by  him 
converted  to  the  Christian  faith.  When  he 
could  keep  him  safe  no  longer,  he  dressed 
him  in  his  own  clothes,  and  enabled  him  to 
escape.  But  the  fury  of  the  persecutors  fell 
upon  Alban,  and  being  ordered  to  offer 
sacrifice  to  their  gods,  and  refusing,  he  was 
terribly  tortured,  and  put  to  death.  It  is 
said  that  the  executioner,  astonished  at 
Alban's  firmness,  and  touched  by  the  grace 
of  God,  declared  himself  a  Christian,  and 
suffered  martyrdom  at  the  same  time,  and 
Amphibalus  soon  after. — Bede,  Eccles.  Hist. 
i.7.    [H.] 

ALBANENSES.  A  sect  which  arose 
probably  in  the  8th  century.  They  held, 
like  the  Manicheans,  the  existence  of  two 
principles,  the  one  good  and  the  other  evil. 
(See  Manicheans.)  They  doned  the  Di- 
vinity, even  the  humanity  of  our  l.ord,  and 
asserted  that  he  did  not  really  sulfer,  die. 


ALBATI 

rise  again,  and  ascend  into  Heaven.  They 
denied  free  will,  rejected  the  idea  of  original 
sin,  and  never  administered  baptism  to 
infants.  The  sect  derived  the  name  from 
Albano,  the  seat  of  the  principal  bishop,  and 
seems  to  have  been  confined  to  Lombardy, 
where  it  originated. — Soames'  Mosheim 
(Stubbs'  Edition),  ii.  149);  Blunt's  Sects, 
p.  14.     [H.] 

ALBATI,  or  WHITE  BEBTHEEN. 
A  set  of  Christian  fanatics  (so  called  from 
the  white  linen  which  they  wore).  Anno 
1399,  in  the  time  of  Pope  Boniface  IX.,  they 
came  down  from  the  Alps  into  several 
provinces  of  Italy,  having  for  their  guide  a 
priest  clothed  all  in  white,  and  a  crucifix  in 
his  hand,  who  asserted  that  he  was  the 
prophet  Elias  sent  to  announce  the  second 
Advent.  So  great  was  his  influence  that  he 
collected  a  band  of  enthusiasts  numbering 
nearly  40,000,  including  some  priests  and 
even  cardinals,  who  marched  in  troops  from 
city  to  city  singing  hymns  and  making  loud 
prayers.  The  pope,  becoming  alarmed  and 
thinking  that  their  leader  aimed  at  his 
chair,  sent  soldiers,  who  apprehended  him 
at  Viterbo  and  brought  him  to  Eome,  where 
he  was  burned  in  1403,  upon  which  his 
followers  dispersed. 

ALBIGENSES.  Eeligionists  in  the 
twelfth  and  thirteenth  centuries  who  opposed 
the  superstitions  and  usages  of  the  Eoman 
Church.  They  were  called  Albigenses  not 
because  they  either  originated  at  Albi, 
or  resided  there  alone,  or  had  their  chief 
church  there,  but  because  they  were  con- 
demned in  a  council  held  a.d.  1176  at 
Albi  (Albigea),  a  town  of  Aquitaine.  The 
name  Albigenses  had  a  twofold  application, 
the  one  limited,  the  other  more  extended. 
In  the  more  limited  sense  the  Albigenses 
were  those  who,  in  Italy,  were  sometimes 
called  Cathari,  Publicani,  or  Pauliciani, 
who  approximated  to  the  Manichasans 
in  their  sentiments.  But  generally  the 
term,  according  to  Peter  Samensi-,  a  ■svriter 
of  that  time,  was  applied  to  all  French  here- 
tics, or  opponents  ot  the  Eoman  aristocracy 
and  hierarchy.  In  1166  Pope  Innocent  III. 
prohibited  all  communion  with  the  Al- 
bigenses, and  sent  into  the  southern  provinces 
of  France  legates  extraordinary  to  extirpate 
heresy,  in  aU  its  forms  and  modifications. 
From  this  that  terrible  tribunal  the  "In- 
quisition "  derived  its  origin.  The  murder 
of  one  of  the  legates,  Peter  of  Gastelnau, 
led  to  the  proclamation  by  the  pope  of  a 
crusade  against  the  Albigenses.  Nearly  half 
a  mOlion  of  men  are  said  to  have  been 
collected  for  it.  It  was  carried  on  with 
merciless  cruelty  in  the  face  of  a  stubborn 
resistance.  Crusade  followed  after  cru- 
sade during  the  first  half  of  the  thirteenth 
century,    and    the    sect    was    not    finally 


ALIENATION 


23 


stamped  out  before  the  beginning  of  the 
fourteenth  century,  when  a  scanty  remnant 
escaped  who  joined  the  Waldenses,  and  a 
few  others  made  their  way  to  Bosnia.  (See 
Stubbs'  Mosheim,  ii.  70,  239;  Faber's 
Waldenses  and  Albigenses  ;  Maitland's  Facts 
and  Documents  illustrative  of  the  IJistory 
of  the  Albigenses,  &c.,  T^p.  95,96;  Sismondi; 
i'leury.) 

The  Albigenses  have  been  frequentlj'- 
confounded  with  the  Waldenses ;  from  whom 
however  it  is  said  that  they  differed  m  many 
respects,  both  as  being  prior  to  them  in 
point  of  time,  as  having  their  origin  in  a 
different  country,  and  as  being  charged 
with  divers  heresies,  particularly  Manichaj- 
ism,  from  which  the  Waldenses  were  exempt. 

ALBIS  (^Dominica  in).   See  Low  hunday. 

A.LESS  or  ALESSE,  ALEXANDBE. 
A  Scotchman  living  at  Leipzic,  who  with 
Sir  John  Clarke  translated  the  first  English 
Prayer  Book  into  Latin.  It  was  very  hasty 
and  imperfect,  but  yet  seems  to  have  been 
used  by  Peter  Martyr  and  Martin  Hucer, 
and  gave  rise  to  many  mistakes.  (See  Blunt's 
Prayer  Book,  i.  xxx. ;  Burnet,  Hist.  Befor. 
ii.  319.)    [H.] 

ALEXANDEIAN  MANUSCEIPT.  One 
of  the  three  most  ancient  copies  of  the 
Scriptures.  Of  the  other  two,  one,  called  the 
Vatican,  is  in  the  Vatican  Library  at  Eome, 
and  the  other,  called  the  Sinaitic,  is  in  the 
Imperial  Library  at  St.  Petersburg.  The 
Alexandrian  is  in  the  Britisli  Museum.  It 
was  sent  to  Charles  I.  by  Cyrillus  Lucaris, 
patriarch  of  Constantinople  about  1628. 
Cyrillus  brought  it  from  Alexandria  (hence 
the  title),  and  it  appears  to  have  had  its 
origin  in  Egypt.  It  is  always  denoted  by 
A  :  the  Vatican  by  B ;  and  the  Sinaitic  by  x- 
(See  Mark's  Gospel.')  There  is  a  schedule 
annexed  to  the  MS.  in  the  British  Museum, 
in  which  Cyrillus  states  that  it  was  written 
by  Thecla,  a  noble  Egyptian  lady,  "  about 
1300  years  ago,"  i.e.  early  in  the  fourth 
century.  There  is  however  no  trustworthy 
evidence  in  support  of  this  statement,  and 
the  opinion  of  antiquarians  is  that  it  was 
written  quite  at  the  end  of  the  fourth 
century,  or  even  as  late  as  the  middle  of 
the  fifth.  It  consists  of  four  folio  volumes, 
of  which  the  first  three  contain  the  Old 
Testament  according  to  the  LXX  version 
almost  complete :  the  fourth  contains  the 
New  Testament,  with  a  few  chasms,  together 
with  the  first  epistle  of  Clement  to  the 
Corinthians,  a  small  fragment  of  the  second, 
and  a  hymn  similar  in  parts  to  our  Te 
Deum. — Marsh's  Michaelis'  Introd.  to  N. 
Test.  vol.  ii.  p.  186  ;  vol.  iii.  p.  655.  (See 
Bible.)   [H.] 

ALIEN  PEIOEIBS.     (See  Priory.) 

ALIENATION,  ecclesiastically  speaking, 
is  the  improper  disposal  of  such  lands  and 


21: 


ALIENATION 


goods  as  have  become  the  property  of  the 
Ghm-ch.  These  being  looked  upon  as 
devoted  to  God  and  his  service,  to  part 
with  them,  or  divert  them  to  any  other  use, 
may  he  considered  as  no  less  than  the 
sin  of  sacrilege.  Upon  some  extraordinary 
occasions,  however,  as  the  redemption  of 
captives  from  slavery,  or  the  relief  of  the 
poor  in  the  time  of  famine,  this  was  per- 
mitted ;  in  which  cases  it  was  not  unusual 
to  sell  even  the  sacred  vessels  and  utensils 
of  the  church.  Some  canons,  if  the  annual 
income  of  the  church  was  not  sufficient  to 
mainiain  the  clergy,  allowed  the  bishop  to 
sell  certain  goods  of  the  church  for  that 
purpose.  By  subsequent  canons,  however, 
this  was  prevented,  unless  the  consent  of 
the  clergy  was  obtained,  and  the  sanction  of 
the  metropolitan,  lest,  under  the  pretence  of 
necessity  or  charity,  any  spoil  or  devastation 
should  be  made  of  the  revenues  of  the 
church.  (See  Bing.  Orig.  Eccl.  lib.  v.  ch. 
vi.  s.  6.)    [H.] 

ALIENATION  IN  MORTMAIN,  is  the 
conveying  or  making  over  lands  or  tene- 
ments to  any  religious  house  or  other 
corporate  body.     (See  Mortmain.') 

ALL  HOLY  MAETYRS  is  a  festival 
observed  in  part  in  the  Eastern  Church,  on  the 
Octave  of  Pentecost — our  Trinity  Sunday. 
St.  Chrysostom  has  left  a  homily,  preached 
upon  this  day.  But  the  Western  Church 
in  later  times  generally  observed  the  Octave 
of  Pentecost  in  honour  of  the  Blessed 
Trinity.     (See  Trinity  Sunday.)    [H.] 

ALL  SAINTS'  DAY.  This  festival  of 
All  Saints  is  not  of  the  highest  antiquity. 
At  the  beginning  of  the  seventh  century  the 
Pantheou  at  Rome,  a  temple  dedicated  to  all 
the  gods,  was  converted  into  a  Christian 
Church  under  the  name  of  the  Blessed  Virgin 
and  all  MartjTS.  This  is  said  to  have 
taken  place  on  November  1,  a.d.  610, 
and  the  ft-stival  seems  to  have  been  observed 
on  that  day  ever  since.  The  Ven.  Bede, 
indeed,  mentions  the  13th  of  May  as  the 
day  of  Martyrs ;  but  in-  another  place  he 
speaks  of  the  festival  as  falling  on  Novem- 
ber 1.  Our  Church  having,  in  the  course 
of  her  year,  celebrated  the  memories  of  the 
holy  apostles,  and  the  other  most  eminent 
saints  and  martyrs  of  the  first  days  of  the 
gospel,  deems  it  unnecessary  to  extend  her 
calendar  by  any  other  particular  festivals, 
but  closes  her  course  with  this  general  one. 
It  should  be  the  Christian's  delight,  on  this 
day,  to  reflect,  as  he  is  moved  by  the 
appointed  scriptures,  on  the  Christian 
graces  and  virtues  which  have  been  ex- 
hibited by  that  goodly  fellowship  of  saints 
who,  in  all  ages,  have  honoured.  God  in  their 
lives,  and  glorified  him  in  their  deaths ;  he 
should  pray  for  grace  to  follow  them  "  in  all 
virtuous    and    godly   living ; "    he   should 


ALL 

meditate  on  the  glorious  rest  that  remains 
for  the  people  of  God,  on  which  they  have 
entered ;  he  should  gratefully  contemplate 
that  communion  of  saints  which  unites  him 
to  their  holy  fellowship,  even  while  he  is 
here  militant,  if  he  be  a  faithful  disciple  of 
the  Saviour  in  whom  they  trusted;  he 
should  earnestly  seek  that  grace  whereby, 
after  a  short  further  time  of  trial,  he  may  be 
united  with  them  in  the  everlasting  sei-vices 
of  the  Church  triumphant.  The  Church  of 
England  seems  to  have  been  induced  to 
sum  up  the  commemoration  of  martyrs, 
confessors,  doctors  and  saints  in  this  one 
day's  service,  from  the  circumstance  of  the 
great  number  of  such  days  in  the  Church  of 
Rome  having  led  to  gross  abuses,  some  of 
which  are  enumerated  in  the  preface  to  the 
Book  of  Common  Prayer. 

This  day  was  popularly  called  "Allhal- 
lows  day."  "  Hallow  E'en "  in  Scotland, 
and  "  Holy  Eve  "  in  Ireland,  means  the  eve 
of  All  Saints'  Day.  It  is  celebrated  as  a 
high  festival,  or  scarlet  day,  at  the  Univer- 
sities of  Oxford  and  Cambridge. 

ALL  SOULS.  A  festival  or  holiday,  on 
which  special  prayers  are  offered  for  the 
souls  of  the  departed.  Its  observance  has 
been  traced  back  to  the  year  998 ;  about 
which  time,  we  are  told,  a  certain  monk, 
whose  curiosity  had  led  him  to  visit  Mount 
Mtaa,,  which  he,  in  common  with  others  of 
that  age,  verily  believed  to  be  the  mouth  of 
hell,  returned  to  his  abbot  with  the  grave 
story  that  he  had  overheard  "the  devils 
within  complain,  that  many  departed  souls 
were  taken  out  of  their  hands  by  the 
prayers  of  the  Cluniac  monks."  (See 
Clugniac  Monks.')  The  compassionate 
abbot  took  the  hint,  and  set  apart  the 
second  day  of  November,  to  be  annually 
kept  by  his  monks  as  a  day  of  prayer  for 
All  Souls  departed.  This  local  appointment 
was  afterwards  changed  by  the  Pope  into  a 
general  one,  obligatory  on  the  Western 
Churches.  Churches  are  dedicated  in 
honour  of  "  All  Souls,"  in  token  that  they 
"are  in  the  hand  of  God,"  and  having 
"  died  in  the  Lord "  are  "  blessed  "  even 
though  they  were  not  such  burning  and 
shining  lights  as  to  be  enrolled  in  the 
catalogue  of  eminent  saints.  For  the  same 
reason  it  was  the  custom  for  Christian 
people  to  deck  the  graves  of  their  friends 
and  relatives  with  flowers  on  this  day. 
The  ceremonies  observed  were  in  good 
keeping  with  the  purpose  of  its  institution. 
In  behalf  of  the  dead,  persons  arrayed  in 
black  perambulated  the  cities  and  towns, 
each  provided  with  a  loud  and  dismal-toned 
bell,  which  they  rang  in  public  places  by 
way  of  exhortation  to  the  people  to  remem- 
ber the  souls  in  purgatory,  and  give  them 
the  aid  of  their  prayers.     (See  Dirge.)    In 


AI.LELUIA 

France  and  Italy,  at  the  present  day,  the 
annual  Jour  des  Marts  is  observed,  by  the 
population  resuming  their  mourning  habits, 
and  visiting  the  graves  of  their  fiiends  for 
many  years  after  their  decease.  At  the 
period  of  the  lleformation  the  Church  of 
England  abrogated  the  observance  of  this 
day.    [H.] 

ALLELUIA,  or  HALLELU-JAH.  This 
is  a  Hebrew  word  signifying  Praise  the 
Lord,  or  Praise  to  the  Lord.  It  occurs  at 
the  beginning  and  at  the  end  of  many  of 
the  Psalms,  and  was  always  sung  by  the 
Jews  on  solemn  days  of  rejoicing.  An 
expression  very  similar  in  sound  seems  to 
have  been  used  by  many  nations,  who  can 
hardly  be  supposed  to  have  borrowed  it  from 
the  Jews.  Hence  it  has  been  supposed  to 
be  one  of  the  most  ancient  words  of  devotion. 
St.  John  retains  the  word  without  transla- 
tion (Rev.  xix.  1,  3,  4,  6) ;  and  among  the 
early  Christians  it  was  so  usual  to  sing 
Hallelujah,  that  St.  Jerome  says  little 
children  were  acquainted  with  it. 

In  evident  imitation  of  the  Jewish  custom, 
the  Church  has  from  very  early  times,  at 
least  during  the  season  of  Easter,  preceded 
the  daily  Psalms  with  Alleluia,  or  Praise  ye 
the  Lord.  In  the  Roman  and  unreformed 
oEBces  it  was  disused  during  certain  peni- 
tential seasons  ;  while  Alleluia  was  used  in 
other  parts  of  the  service  also  during  the 
Easter  season,  &c.  In  the  First  Book  of 
King  Edward  VI.,  Allelujah  was  sung  after 
"  Praise  ye  the  Lord,"  from  Easter  to  Triaity 
Sunday.  The  response,  "  The  Lord's  name 
be  praised,"  was  added  at  the  last  review. 
It  had  been  inserted  in  the  Scotch  Liturg}"- 
in  King  Charles  I.'s  time.  (See  Gloria 
-Pafri.)— Jebb's  Clwral  Service. 

ALMERY.  Literally  "a  place  for  the 
ahns,"  but  the  teiTa  is  applied  generally  to 
recesses  in  the  walls  of  churches,  fitted 
with  shelves  and  secured  by  doors,  as 
receptacles  for  the  altar,  vessels,  or  any 
other  valuable  articles  of  church  furniture. 
They  are  to  be  found  not  only  by  the  side  of 
the  altar,  but  in  various  other  parts  of  old 
churches ;  and  sometimes  in  the  cloisters. 

ALMOIGN,  FRANK.  (See  Frank 
Almoifjn.') 

ALMONER.  An  officer  in  monasteries, 
who  had  the  care  of  the  Almonry.  In  the 
cathedral  of  St.  Paul,  London,  the  Almoner 
had  the  distribution  of  the  alms,  and  the 
care  of  the  burial  of  the  poor.  He  also 
educated  eight  boys  in  musip  and  in  litera- 
ture, for  the  service  of  the  Church.  The 
office  afterwards  was  practically  that  of  a 
Choir-master,  or  Master  of  the  Boys,  and 
was  usually  held  by  a  Vicar  Choral. — 
Dugdale's  History  of  St.  Paul's. 

The  Lord  High  Almoner  is  a  Prelate, 
who  has  the  disposing  of  the  King's  Alms, 


ALMS 


25 


and  of  other  sums  accruing  to  the  Crown. 
Till  King  James  I.'s  accession,  when  the 
office  of  Dean  of  the  Chapel  Royal  was 
revived,  he  had  the  care  of  the  King's 
Chapel ;  his  office  being  then  analogous  to 
that  of  the  Grand  Almoner  of  France. — 
Heylin's  Life  of  Laud. 

ALMONRY.  A  room  where  alms  were 
distributed,  generally  near  to  the  church, 
or  a  part  of  it.  The  Almomies  in  the  prin- 
cipal monasteries  were  often  great  establish- 
ments, with  endowments  specially  appropri- 
ated to  their  sustentation,  having  a  chaiDel, 
hall,  and  chambers  for  the  accommodation 
of  the  poor  and  infirm.  The  remains  of  the 
Almonry  at  Canterbury,  for  example,  are 
extensive  and  interesting. — Jebb's  Choral 
Service. 

ALMS.  (Sax.  almes  ;  Old  Eng.  almism 
or  almose ;  Germ,  almosen ;  Norw.  cdm- 
oignes ;  Fr.  aumune  ;  Gr.  ikejjiioa-vvr]).  Any- 
thing given  gratuitously  to  relieve  the  poor, 
as  money,  food  or  clothing.  In  the  primitive 
Church,  the  people  who  were  of  sufficient 
substance  used  to  give  alms  to  the  poor 
every  Sunday,  as  they  entered  the  church. 
And  the  poor,  who  were  approved  and 
selected  by  the  deacons  or  other  ministers, 
were  exhorted  to  stand  before  the  church 
doors  to  ask  for  alms,  as  the  lame  man,  who 
was  healed  by  Peter  and  John,  at  the 
Beautiful  Gate  of  the  temple.  The  collec- 
tion of  alms  at  the  time  of  Holy  Communion 
is  mentioned  by  Justin  Martyr  (a.d.  139) 
as  an  invariable  rule,  and  is  supposed  to  be 
based  on  the  direction  of  St.  Paul,  1  Cor 
xvi.  2. — St.  Chrys.  Horn.  xxv.  de  verh.  Apos. ; 
Bing.  bk.  xiii.  c.  viii.  11.  The  order  in  our 
Church  is,  that  the  alms  should  be  collected 
at  that  part  of  the  Holy  Communion  Service 
which  is  called  the  Offertory,  while  the  sen- 
tences are  in  reading  which  follow  the  place 
appointed  for  the  sermon.  The  intention  of 
the  compilers  of  our  service  was,  that  these 
alms  should  be  collected  every  Sunday,  as 
is  plain  from  the  directions  in  tlie  rubric ; 
and  this,  whether  there  was  a  celebration 
or  not.  It  is  much  to  be  regretted  that  the 
decay  of  charity  has  caused  this  good 
custom  to  fall  into  too  general  disuse ;  but 
it  is  one  which  churchmen  are  endeavouring 
to  restore,  and  in  many  cases  they  have 
succeeded.     (See  Offertory.') 

In  the  seventeenth  century  extraordinary 
collections  of  alms  were  made  in  England 
on  certain  occasions,  by  letters  patent  from 
the  Sovereign.     (See  Briefs.) 

The  word  alms  is  now  used  as  a  plural, 
but  it  was  originally  a  singular  noun.  (Acts 
iii.3.)     [H.]  ^ 

ALMS-CHEST.  Besides  the  alms  col- 
lected at  the  offertory,  it  may  be  supposed 
that  devout  persons  would  make  contribu- 
tions to  the  poor  on  entering  the  church, 


2G 


ALOGIANS 


or  departing  from  it,  at  eveniug  service; 
and  to  receive  tliese  alms,  it  is  appointed 
by  the  84tli  Canon,  that  a  chest  bo  provided 
and  placed  in  the  church. 

ALOGIAJS'S.  Heretics  in  the  second 
century,  who  denied  the  Divine  Logos,  or 
Word,  and  attributed  the  vs'ritings  of  St. 
John,  in  which  the  Second  Person  of  the 
Godhead  is  so  styled,  to  Cerinthus.  St. 
Augustine  traces  their  origin  to  Theodotus 
of  Byzantium.  {Hier.  lib.  iv.  1,  and  sxx. ; 
Bpiph.  Ussr.  lib.  i.,  adv.  Alog.  3.) 

ALPHKGE,  ST.  Archbishop  M.  Com- 
memorated in  the  English  Calendar  on 
April  19.  His  name  is  also  written  M\- 
pheah,  Alfegus,  and  Elphege.  He  was  of 
noble  family,  and  in  984  was  made  Bishop 
of  Winchester.  He  was  translated  to  the 
see  of  Canterbury  in  1009.  Two  years 
after,  the  Danes  having  gained  possession  of 
the  city  and  taken  the  archbishop  captive, 
demanded  a  ransom  which  at  first  he  pro- 
mised to  pay,  but  afterwards  refused, 
because  he  could  not  raise  the  required  sum 
except  by  parting  with  some  of  the  treasures 
of  the  Church,  or  by  wringing  it  from  his 
tenants.  After  being  kept  seven  months  a 
prisoner  in  the  Danish  ships,  he  was  dragged 
forth  and  brutally  stoned  to  death  at 
Greenwich,  on  the  site  of  the  parish  church, 
which  is  dedicated  to  him.  (See  Hook's 
Lives  of  the  Archhishops,  vol.  i.  p.  455.) 
He  was  buried  in  St.  Paul's  and  afterwards 
translated  to  Canterbury.  (See  Freeman, 
Norman  Conq.  i.  350-2,and  Appx. II.)    [H.] 

ALPHABET  PSALMS.  Three  psalms, 
in  which  each  verse  or  clause  in  the 
Hebrew,  begins  with  the  successive  letters 
of  the  alphabet.  These  are  especially 
the  111th,  112th,  and  119th  Psalms. 
The  latter  is  of  a  peculiar  character.  Each 
division  is  made  of  verses  which  begin  with 
the  same  letter,  the  section  answering  to  the 
verses  of  the  other  alphabet  psalms.  (See 
Acrostic.') 

ALTAR.  (Lat.  altare,  prob.  from  alius, 
high;  Celt,  alt.)  Originally  a  mount  or 
structm-e  on  which  sacrifices  were  offered. 
In  the  Christian  use  of  the  word  it  will  be 
convenient  to  consider  (i.)  the  name,  (ii.) 
the  material,  (iii.)  the  iDosition  of  the 
altar. 

I.  Altar  was  the  name  by  which  the 
holy  board  was  constantly  distinguished  for 
the  first  three  hundred  years  after  Christ ; 
during  all  which  time  it  does  not  appear 
that  it  was  above  once  called  "  table,"  and 
that  was  in  a  letter  of  Dionysius  of  Alexan- 
dria to  Xystus  of  Rome.  And  when,  in  the 
fourth  century,  Athanasius  called  it  a 
"  table,"  he  thought  himself  obliged  to 
explain  the  word,  and  to  let  the  reader  know 
that  by  table  he  meant  altar,  that  being 
then,     the     constant    and    familiar    name. 


ALTAR 

Afterwards,  indeed,  both  names  came  to  be 
promiscuously  used ;  the  one  having  respect 
to  the  oblation  of  the  Eucharist,  the  other  to 
the  participation. — Wheatly. 

St.  Ignatius,  who  lived  in  the  Apostolic 
age  itself,  says,  "  In  every  church  there  is 
an  altar  "  (ad  Philipp.).  Other  early  fathers 
frequently  allude  to  the  Christian  altar  as  an 
object  familiar  to  Christian  sight ;  and  in 
a  detailed  description  of  the  Cathedral  of 
Tyre,  given  by  Eusebius  in  his  dedication 
sermon,  he  distinctly  names  the  holy  altar 
(ayiov  Bvtnaa-Tripiov)  placed  in  the  midst  of 
the  apse,  at  the  east  end  of  the  church.  There 
were,  however,  distinct  names  given  by 
early  Christian  writers  to  the  heathen  altar 
(jSm/ios-),  and  the  altar  of  the  Church 
(dva-Mo-TTipiov),  and  while  they  constantly 
declare  they  had  not  the  fonner,  they 
frequently  speak  of  the  latter,  as  that  on 
which  was  offered  the  Christian  sacrifice 
{6va-ia)  of  the  Holy  Eucharist.— Blunt, 
Annot.  P.  B.  ii.  p.  158. 

Irenasus  and  Origen  use  the  same  word 
as  Ignatius.  TertuUian  frequently  applies 
to  it  the  name  of  "  Ara  Dei,"  and  "  Altare." 
Cyprian  uses  both  names,  table  and  altar ; 
but  most  commonly  altar. 

By  St.  John  Chiysostom  it  is  most  usually 
termed,  "the  mystical  and  tremendous 
table,"  &c.  St.  Augustine  usually  gives  it  the 
name  of  Mensa  Domini,  the  Lord's  Table. 
"  It  were  easy  to  add  a  thousand  other  testi- 
monies, where  the  altar  is  called  the  Holy 
Table,-  to  signify  to  us  their  notion  of  the 
Christian  sacrifice  and  altar  at  once,  that  it 
was  mystical  and  spiritual,  and  had  no 
relation  either  to  the  bloody  sacrifices  of  the 
Jews,  or  the  idolatries  of  the  Gentiles,  but 
served  only  for  the  service  of  the  Eucharist, 
and  the  oblations  of  the  people." — Bingham, 
Ant.  viii.  vi.  14. 

In  the  First  Prayer  Book  of  King  Edward 
VI.  the  terms  used  for  this  holy  table  are  the 
Altar,  and  Ood's  Board.  In  November  1550 
an  order  was  issued  from  the  Privy  Council 
to  every  bishop  "  to  pluck  down  the  altars," 
and  in  the  lieu  of  them  "  to  set  up  a  table 
in  some  convenient  place  of  the  chancel." 
This  order  was  very  much  resented  in  somo 
dioceses  by  the  people  as  well  as  by  the 
clergy  and  the  bishops.  Daye,  Bishop  of 
Chichester,  refused  to  obey  the  order,  saying 
that  "  he  slicked  not  in  the  form,  situation, 
or  the  matter,  stone  or  wood  of  the  altar ; 
these  things  he  considered  indifferent,  but 
the  commandment  to  take  down  all  altars 
and  put  a  table  instead  seemed  to  him  a 
plain  abolishment  of  the  altars,  both  the 
name  and  the  thing,  and  he  could  not 
consent  to  it."  He  was  consequently 
deprived  of  his  bishopric.  This  order  for 
the  conversion  of  "  altars ''  into  "  tables  " 
was  mainly  owing  to  the  influence  of  Hooper 


ALTAK 

and  others  who  had  adopted  the  low  sacra- 
mental views  of  the  Swiss  reformers. 

In  the  Second  Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI. 
the  term  "  Altar  "  was  omitted,  and  "  Table," 
"Holy  Table,"  or  "Lord's  Table,"  sub- 
stituteil,  which  names  were  retained  at  the 
last  revision  in  i6ij2.  The  phrase  "com- 
munion table  "  occurs  in  the  Canons  only,  as 
in  the  20th,  and  the  82nd.  The  word  altar 
is  used  in  the  Coronation  Service.  It  is 
employed  without  scruple  by  Bishop  Overall, 
one  of  the  commissioners  for  the  revision 
of  the  Liturgy  in  King  James  I.'s  reign,  and 
by  those  who  were  employed  in  the  last 
Review  in  1662,  who  of  course  understood 
the  real  spirit  of  the  Church  of  England. 
For  example,  the  following  are  the  words  of 
Bishop  Sparrow,  one  of  the, Ee viewers. 

"  That  no  man  take  otTence  at  the  word 
Altar,  let  him  know,  that  anciently  both 
these  names.  Altar,  or  Holy  Table,  were 
used  for  the  same  thing ;  though  most  fre- 
quently the  fathers  and  councils  use  the 
word  Altar.  And  both  are  fit  names  for 
that  holy  thing.  For  the  Holy  Eucharist 
being  considered  as  a  sacrifice,  in  the  repre- 
sentation of  the  breaking  of  the  bread,  and 
pouring  forth  of  the  cup,  doing  that  to  the 
holy  symbols  which  was  done  to  Christ's 
body  and  blood,  and  so  showing  forth  and 
commemorating  the  Lord's  death,  and 
offering  upon  it  the  same  sacrifice  that  was 
offered  upon  the  cross,  or  rather  the  com- 
memoration of  that  sacrifice,  (St.  Chrysost. 
in  Eeb.  x.  9,)  it  may  fitly  be  called  an 
Altar ;  which  again  is  as  fitly  called  an 
Holy  Table,  the  Eucharist  being  considered 
as  a  Sacrament,  which  is  nothing  else  but  a 
distribution  and  application  of  the  sacrifice 
to  the  several  receivers."  Bishop  Cosins 
(^NichoU's  add.  notes,  p.  42)  speaks  of  the 
king  and  queen  presenting  their  offering  "  on 
their  knees  at  God's  altar :  "  though  he  adds 
afterwards  (p.  50)  on  the  passage  "  This  our 
sacrifice  of  praise  and  thanksgiving," — "  In 
which  regard  and  divers  others  besides,  the 
Eucharist  may  by  allusion,  analogy,  and  ex- 
trinsical denomination,  be  fitly  called  a 
sacrifice,  and  the  Lord's  table  an  altar,  the  one 
relating  to  the  other ;  though  neither  of  them 
can  be  strictly  and  properly  so  called.  .  . .  The 
sacrament  of  the  Eucharist  carries  the  name 
of  a  sacrifice  ;  and  the  table,  whereon  it  is 
celebrated,  an  altar  of  oblation,  in  a  far 
higher  sense  than  any  of  their  former  sacri- 
fices did,  which  were  but  the  types  and 
figures  of  those  services,  which  are  performed 
in  recognition  and  memory  of  Christ's  own 
sacrifice,  once  offered  upon  the  altar  of  his 
cross  "  Bishop  Andrewes  says :  "  The  Holy 
Eucharist  being  considered  as  a  sacrifice,  it 
is  'fitly  called  an  Altar,  which  again  is  fitly 
called  a  Table,  the  Eucharist  being-  con- 
sidered  as  a  sacrament."     Again,  Bishop 


ALTAH 


27 


Beveridge,  on  the  necessity,  &c.,  of  frequent 
communion,  uses  the  word  ;  "  Upon  Sundays 
and  holy  days,  although  there  be  not  such 
a  number,  and  therefore  no  communion,  yet, 
howevei",  the  priest  shall  go  up  to  the  altar," 
&c.  And  Bishop  Bull  (charge  to  the  clergy 
of  St.  David's),  "Before  the  Priest  goes  to 
the  Altar  to  read  the  second  service,"  &c. 

Heuce,  though  not  presuming  to  dispute 
the  wisdom  of  the  Reviewers,  or,  to  speak 
more  reverently,  the  dispositions  of  God's 
providence,  whereby  the  use  of  the  word 
altar  was  withheld  from  our  Prayer  Book, 
there  can  be  no  doubt  that  the  employment 
of  the  woid  can  be  justified,  if  we  under- 
stand it  as  the  ancient  Church  understood 
it. 

[Nevertheless  it  has  been  decided  in  the 
ecclesiastical  courts  that  the  Church  of 
England  has  no  altars,  but  only  a  holy 
table  or  a  communion  table,  which  was 
called  in  the  early  Prayer  Books,  but  not 
in  the  later,  "  God's  Board."  This  was  first 
decided  in  the  celebrated  stone  altar  case  of 
Faulkner  v.  Lichfield  (1  Robertson,  184), 
against  a  new  stone  altar  in  the  Round 
Church  at  Cambridge,  and  again  in  one  of 
the  stages  of  the  Liddell  v.  Westerton  case, 
on  St.  Paul's,  Knightsbridge,  and  St.  Barna- 
bas Churches  (Broderick  and  Premantle's 
Ecc.  J.  122)  ;  where,  also,  it  was  said  in  the 
judgment  that  stone  altars  are  not  only 
illegal  because  they  are  immovable,  but 
because  they  are  not  made  of  wood.  The 
same  jwint  was  decided  in  Parlcer  v.  Leach 
(L.  R.  1  P.  C.  312),  which  has  always  since 
been  followed,  and  an  Act  was  subsequently 
passed,  declaring  the  law  accordingly  for 
the  validity  of  marriages  (which  is  a  civil 
question  of  State  law  entirely),  that  the 
removal  of  the  communion  table  in  re- 
building and  enlarging  a  church  does  not 
require  a  reoonsecration,  as  had  been  as- 
sumed in  a  former  judgment  of  a  diocesan 
court,  thereby  reversed  or  superseded.    [G].] 

II.  In  the  ancient  church,  altars  were 
made  both  of  wood  and  stone.  One  of  wood 
is  preserved  in  the  church  of  St.  John 
Lateran  at  Rome,  of  such  ancient  date  that 
there  is  a  tradition  that  it  was  used  by  St. 
Peter.  It  is  in  the  form  of  the  Ark,  on  the 
lid,  or  mensa,  of  which  the  Eucharist  was 
celebraterl.  A  small  portable  altar  also  of 
wood,  but  covered  with  silver,  said  to  have 
been  used  by  St.  Cuthbert  in  the  seventh 
century,  is  preserved  in  Durham  Cathedral 
Library.  In  St.  Augustine's  time  wooden 
altars  were  in  use  in  African  churches,  while 
stone  altars  existed  in  some  of  the  churches 
of  Asia.  The  Council  of  Epone  in  Gaul  (a.d. 
51 7)  enjoined  stone  altars,  while  in  England 
wooden  altars,  according  to  William  of 
Malmesbury,  were  in  common  use.  In  the 
eleventh  century  Wulfstan,  bishop  of  Wor- 


28 


ALTAE 


coster,  ordered  all  the  wooden  altars  in  his 
diocese  to  be  changed  for  altars  of  stone.  They 
are  generally  of  wood  in  the  Eastern  Church. 
(See  Blunt,  P.  B.  p.  158).  The  substitution 
of  wood  for  stone  was  involved  in  the  order 
to  convert  the  "  altars  "  into  "  tables."  (See 
Mensa.) 

III.  The  place  of  the  high  altar  was 
uniformly,  in  England  at  least,  at  the  east  end 
of  the  church  ;  but  in  large  churches  room 
is  left  for  processions  to  pass  behind  it,  and 
in  cathedral  churches  of  Norman  foundation 
for  the  bishop's  throne.  Where  the  end  of 
the  church  was  apsidal,  the  high  altar  was 
placed  in  the  chord  of  the  apse.  Chantry 
altars,  not  being  connected  with  a  service 
in  which  processions  were  used,  were  placed 
against  the  wall,  and  scarcely  an  aisle  or  a 
transept  was  without  one  or  more.  There 
were  tour  at  the  rood  screen  across  the  nave 
of  St.  Alban's,  and  several  more  against  the 
pillars.  In  form  the  high  altar  was  generally 
large  and  plain,  relying  for  decoration  wholly 
on  the  rich  furniture  with  which  it  was 
loaded ;  very  rarely  its  front  was  panelled  or 
otherwise  ornamented.  Chantry  altars  were, 
perhaps,  in  ninety-nine  cases  in  a  hundred, 
mere  slabs  built  into  the  walL  At  Jervaulx, 
however,  at  the  end  of  each  aisle,  is  a  large 
plain  altar  built  up  of  separate  stones,  much 
in  the  form  of  a  high  tomb.  Jn  situ  but 
few  high  altars  remain,  but  chantiy  altars 
in  situ  are  frequent  enough.  They  are  not, 
however,  often  found  in  the  aisles  and 
transepts  of  our  churches,  but  in  places 
where  they  would  more  readily  escape  ob- 
servation, as,  for  instance,  under  the  east 
window  (or  foiToing  its  sill)  of  a  vestry,  or 
of  a  parvise,  or  in  a  gateway  to  a  monas- 
tery, or  in  private  chapels  and  chapels  of 
castles.  Altar  stones  not  in  situ,  but  used  in 
pavements  and  all  kinds  of  places,  are  almost 
innumerable,  sometimes  two  or  three  or 
more  occurring  in  a  single  small  church. 
They  may  be  recognised  by  five  little 
crosses,  one  in  the  centre,  and  one  at  each 
corner.  The  multiplication  of  altars  in  the 
same  church  is  still  strictly  forbidden  in  the 
Eastern  Church,  as  it  was  in  ancient  times. 
(See  Bingham,  bk.  viii.  c.  6.  §  16.) 

"  In  the  reign  of  Edward  VI.,  besides  the 
dispute  about  turning  the  altars  into  tables, 
which  was  originated  in  a  sermon  by  Bishop 
Hooper  preached  before  the  King  (Edw.  VI.), 
another  controversy  arose,  viz.  whether  the 
table,  placed  in  the  room  of  the  altar,  ought 
to  stand  altarwise ;  i.e.  in  the  same  place 
and  situation  as  the  altar  formerly  stood? 
This  was  the  occasion  that  in  some  churches 
the  tables  were  placed  in  the  middle  of  the 
chancels,  in  others  at  the  east  part  thereof, 
next  to  the  wall.  Bishop  Ridley  endea- 
voured to  compromise  this  matter,  and 
therefore,  in  St.  Paul's  Cathedral,  suffered 


ALTAR 

the  table  to  stand  in  the  place  of  the  old 
altar  ;  but  beating  down  the  wainscot  parti- 
tion behind,  laid  all  the  choir  open  to  the 
east,  leaving  the  table  then  to  stand  in  the 
middle  of  the  chancel.  Under  this  diversity 
of  usage,  things  went  on  till  the  death  of 
King  Edward;  when,  Queen  Mary  coming 
to  the  throne,  altars  were  again  restored 
wherever  they  had  been  demolished;  but 
her  reign  proving  short,  and  Queen  Eliza- 
beth succeeding  her,  the  people  (just  got 
free  again  from  the  tyranny  of  Popery) 
through  a  mistaken  zeal  fell  in  a  tumultu- 
ous manner  to  the  pulling  down  of  altars ; 
though,  indeed,  this  hapi^ened  for  the  ge- 
nerality only  in  private  churches,  they  not 
being  meddled  with  in  any  of  the  queen's 
chapels,  and  in  but  very  few  of  the  cathe- 
drals. And  as  soon  as  the  queen  was  sensi- 
ble of  what  had  happened  in  other  places, 
she  put  out  an  injunction  to  restrain  the 
fury  of  the  people,  declaring  it  to  be  no 
matter  of  great  moment,  whether  there 
were  altars  or  tables,  so  that  the  sacrament 
was  duly  and  reverently  administered ;  but 
ordering,  that  where  altars  were  taken 
down,  holy  tables  should  be  decently  made, 
and  set  in  the  place  where  the  altars  stood, 
and  so  to  stand,  saving  when  the  commu- 
nion of  the  sacrament  was  to  be  distributed ; 
at  which  time  the  same  was  to  be  so  placed 
in  good  sort  within  the  chancel,  as  thereby 
the  minister  might  be  more  conveniently 
heard  of  the  communicants  in  his  prayer 
and  ministration,  and  the  communicants 
also  more  conveniently  and  in  more  number 
communicate  with  the  said  minister.  And 
after  the  communion,  done  from  time  to 
time,  the  same  holy  table  was  to  be  placed 
where  it  stood  before.  Pursuant  hereunto, 
this  part  of  the  present  rubric  was  added  to 
the  liturgy,  in  the  first  year  of  her  reign, 
viz.  that  "  the  table,  at  the  communion 
time,  having  a  fair  white  linen  cloth  upon 
it,  shall  stand  in  the  body  of  the  church,  or 
in  the  chancel,  where  morning  and  evening 
prayer  are  appointed  to  be  said : "  which 
was  in  those  times  generally  in  the  chom 
But  then  it  is  plain  from  the  aforesaid 
injunction,  as  well  as  from  the  eighty-second 
Canon  of  the  Church,  (which  is  almost 
verbatim  the  same,)  that  there  is  no  obliga- 
tion arising  from  this  rubric  to  move  the 
table  at  the  time  of  the  communion,  unless 
the  people  cannot  otherwise  conveniently 
hear  and  communicate.  The  injunction 
declares,  that  the  holy  tables  are  to  be  set 
in  the  same  place  where  the  altars  stood, 
which  every  one  knows  was  at  the  east  end 
of  the  chancel.  And  when  both  the  injunc- 
tion and  canon  speak  of  its  being  moved  at 
the  time  of  the  communion,  it  supposes 
that  the  minister  could  not  otherwise  bo 
heard  :  the  interposition  of  a  belfry  between 


ALTAKAGE 

the  chancel  and  body  of  the  church  hinder- 
ing the  minister  in  some  chm-ches  from 
being  heard  by  the  people,  if  he  continued 
in  the  church.  And  with  the  same  view 
seems  this  rubric  to  have  been  added,  and 
which  therefore  lays  us  under  no  obligation 
to  move  the  table,  unless  necessity  requires. 
But  whenever  the  churches  are  built  so  as 
the  minister  can  be  heard,  and  conveniently 
administer  the  sacrament  at  the  place  where 
the  table  usually  stands,  he  is  rather  obliged 
to  administer  in  the  chancel,  (that  being 
the  sanctum  sanctorum,  or  most  holy  place, 
of  the  church,)  as  appears  from  the  rubric 
before  the  Commandments,  as  also  from 
that  before  the  Absolution,  by  both  which 
rubrics  the  priest  is  directed  to  turn  himself 
to  the  people.  From  whence  I  argue,  that 
if  the  table  be  in  the  middle  of  the  church, 
and  the  people  consequently  round  about 
the  minister,  the  minister  cannot  turn  him- 
self to  the  people  any  more  at  one  time  than 
another.  Whereas,  if  the  table  he  close 
to  the  east  wall,  the  minister  stands  on  the 
north  side,  and  looks  southward,  and  con- 
sequently, by  looking  westward,  turns 
himself  to  the  people." — Wheatly. 

The  permission  given  in  Queen  Elizabeth's 
injunction  to  move  the  "  Holy  Table  "  from 
the  east  end  at  the  time  of  Holy  Commu- 
nion, and  to  place  it  in  "  good  sort  witliin 
the  chancel  as  thereby  the  minister  might 
be  more  conveniently  heard,"  &c.,  was  taken 
advantage  of  by  the  Puritan  party,  and  in  a 
large  number  of  parish  churches  the  table 
was  placed  lengthways  in  the  body  of  the 
chancel,  and  stood  there  permanently,  no 
regard  being  paid  to  the  direction  contained 
in  the  injunction  that  after  the  communion 
done,  the  same  holy  table  was  to  be  placed 
where  it  stood  before."  The  consequence 
was  that  it  was  often  treated  with  the  most 
shocking  irreverence.  Laud  soon  after  his 
appointment  to  the  Primacy  endeavoured  to 
put  a  stop  to  this  by  ordering  the  holy 
tables  to  be  placed  altarwise  at  the  east  end 
of  the  chancels,  and  on  the  whole,  in  spite 
of  much  vehement  opposition,  the  order 
was  successfiilly  enforced ;  and,  except 
during  the  confusion  of  the  Commonwealth, 
the  rule  has  prevailed  from  that  time  to  the 
present  day.  In  the  royal  chapels,  and  in 
most,  if  not  all,  of  the  cathedral  churches, 
no  change  was  made  at  any  time  in  the 
position  of  the  altar.    [H.] 

ALTARAGE.  A  legal  term  used  to  denote 
the  profits  arising  to  the  priest  or  parson 
of  the  parish  on  account  of  the  altar,  called 
obventio  altaris.  Since  the  Eeformation 
there  has  been  much  dispute  as  to  the  ex- 
tent of  the  vicar's  claim  upon  tithes  as 
altarage.  In  the  21st  Eliz.  it  was  decided 
that  the  words  Alteragium  cum  manso 
competenti  would  entitle  him  to  the  small 


ALTAR 


29 


tithes ;  but  it  has  since  been  holden  and 
now  generally  understood,  that  the  extent 
of  the  altarage  depends  entirely  upon  usage 
and  the  manner  of  endowment. 

ALTAR  CLOTH.  By  the  82nd  Canon 
it  is  appointed  that  the  table  provided  for  the 
celebration  of  the  Holy  Communion  shall 
be  covered,  in  time  of  divine  service,  with  a 
carpet  of  silk,  or  other  decent  stuff  thought 
meet  by  the  ordinary  of  the  place,  if  any 
question  be  made  of  it ;  and  with  a  fair 
linen  cloth  at  the  time  of  the  ministration, 
as  becometh  that  table.  The  sovereigns 
of  England,  at  their  coronation,  present,  as 
their  first  oblation,  a  pall  or  altar  cloth  of 
gold,  &c.  Fringed  white  cloths  at  the 
communion  have  been  declared  illegal,  and 
the  colours  of  the  cloth  at  other  times  are 
to  be  decided  by  the  ordinary.  Liddell  v. 
Westerton.     (See  Litjhts;  Cross.')    [H.] 

ALTAR  PIECE. '  A  picture  placed  over 
the  altar.  It  is  not  uncommon  in  English 
churches  to  place  paintings  over  the  altar, 
although  it  is  a  practice  of  modern  intro- 
duction, and  although  there  would  be  a 
prejudice  against  placing  paintings  in  other 
parts  of  the  church.  The  English  Reform- 
ers were  very  strongly  opposed  to  the  intro- 
duction of  paintings  into  the  sanctuary. 
In  Queen  Ehzabeth's  reign,  a  proclamation 
was  issued  against  pictures  as  well  as  images 
in  churches ;  and  Dean  Nowell  fell  under 
her  Majesty's  displeasure  for  procuring  for 
her  use  a  Prayer  Book  with  pictures.  The 
Puritans,  who  formed  the  religious  world 
of  King  Charles's  time,  both  in  the  Church 
and  out  of  it,  destroyed  pictures  wherever 
they  could  find  ,them,  as  relics  of  Popery. 
We  may  add  that  the  feeling  against  pic- 
tures prevailed  not  only  in  modem  times, 
but  in  the  first  ages  of  the  primitive  Chm'ch. 
In  the  various  catalogues  of  church  furni- 
ture that  we  possess,  we  never  read  of 
pictures.  There  is  a  particular  breviat  of 
the  things  found  by  the  persecutors  in  the 
church  of  Paul,  bishop  of  Cirta,  in  Numidia 
(a.d.  303),  where  we  find  mention  made 
of  cups,  flagons,  two  candlesticks,  and  vest- 
ments; but  of  images  and  pictures  there 
is  not  a  syllable.  In  Spain,  at  the  Council 
of  Eliberis,  a.d.  306,  ihere  was  a  positive 
decree  against  them.  And,  at  the  end  of 
that  century,  Epiphanius,  passing  through 
Anablatha,  a  village  of  Palestine,  found  a 
veil  there,  hanging  before  the  doors  of  the 
sanctuary  in  the  church,  whereon  was 
painted  the  image  of  Christ,  or  some  samt, 
which  he  immediately  tore  in  pieces,  and 
gave  it  as  a  winding-sheet  for  the  poor, 
himself  replacing  the  hanging  by  one 
from  Cyprus.  (,Ep.  ad  Jolian.  Hierosol.y 
The  first  mention  of  pictures  we  find 
at  the  close  of  the  fourth  century ;  when 
Paulinus,   bishop     of    Nola,  to    keep  the 


30 


ALTAR 


•country  people  employed,  when  they  came 
together  to  observe  the  festival  of  the 
dedication  of  the  church  of  St.  Felix, 
ordered  the  church  to  he  painted  with  the 
images  of  saints,  and  stories  from  Scripture 
history,  such  as  those  of  Esther  and  Job, 
and  Tobit  and  Judith.  {Pavlinus  Natal. 
9.  Felicis,  p.  615.)  The  reader  will  find  a 
learned  historical  investigation  of  this  sub- 
ject in  note  B  to  the  translation  of  Tertul- 
lian's  Apology  in  the  Library  of  the  Fathers, 
which  is  thus  summed  up :  1.  In  the  first 
three  centuries  it  is  positively  stated  that 
Christians  had  no  images.  2.  Private  in- 
dividuals had  pictures,  but  it  was  dis- 
couraged. 3.  The  cross,  not  the  crucifix, 
was  used;  the  first  mention  of  the  cross 
in  a  church  is  in  the  time  of  Constan- 
tine.  4.  The  first  mention  of  pictures  in 
churches,  except  to  forbid  them,  is  at  the 
end  of  the  fourth  centurj^  and  these  his- 
torical pictures  from  the  Old  Testament,  or 
of  martyrdoms,  not  of  individuals.  5.  No 
account  of  any  picture  of  our  Lord  being 
publicly  used  occurs  in  the  first  six  cen- 
turies ;  the  first  is  a.d.  600.  6.  Outward 
reverence  to  pictures  is  condemned.  We 
find  frequent  allusion  to  pictures  in  the 
writings  of  St.  Augustine.  We  thus  see 
that  the  use  of  pictures  in  churches  is  to 
be  traced  to  the  fourth  century ;  and  we 
may  presume  that  the  practice  of  the  age, 
when  the  Church  was  beginning  to  breathe 
after  its  severe  persecutions,  when  the  great 
creed  of  the  Church  Universal  was  drawn 
up,  and  when  the  canon  of  Scripture  was 
fixed,  is  sufficient  to  sanction  the  use  of 
pictures  in  our  sanctuaries.  That  in  the 
middle  ages,  pictures  as  well  as  images  were 
sometimes  worshipped,  as  they  are  by  many 
Papists  in  the  present  day,  is  not  to  be 
denied.  (See  Images ;  Image  Worship.) 
It  was  therefore  natural  that  the  Reformers, 
.seeing  the  abuse  of  the  thing,  should  be 
.strongly  prejudiced  against  the  retention 
•of  pictures  in  our  clmrohes.  But  much 
■of  Roman  error  consists  in  the  abuse  of 
what  was  originally  good  or  true.  We 
aiiay,  in  the  present  age,  return  to  the  use  of 
what  was  originally  good ;  but  being  warned 
ihat  what  has  led  to  Popish  corruptions 
may  lead  to  them  again,  we  must  be  very 
.careful  to  watch  against  the  recurrence  of 
those  evil  practices  to  which  these  customs 
have  been  abused  or  perverted. 

ALTAR  RAILS,  as  such,  and  as  dis- 
tinguished from  the  chancel  screen,  were 
not  known  in  the  Western  Church  before 
the  Reformation.  We  probably  owe  them 
to  Archbishop  Laud,  who,  irt  order  to  guard 
iigainst  a  continuance  of  the  profanations 
;to  which  the  holy  table  had  been  subjected, 
while  standing  in  the  nave  of  the  church, 
•or  in  the  middle  of  the  chancel,  ordered  that 


AMBO 

it  should  be  placed  at  the  east  end  of  the 
chancel,  and  protected  from  rude  approach 
by  rails.  As  the  use  of  altar  rails  arose  out 
of,  and  visibly  signified  respect  for,  the 
great  mysteries  celebrated  at  the  altar,  they 
were,  of  course,  a  mark  for  the  hostility  of 
the  Puritans ;  and  accordingly,  in  the 
journal  of  William  Dowsing,  parliamentary 
visitor  of  churches  in  the  great  rebellion, 
we  find  that  they  were  everywhere  de- 
stroyed. They  have  generally,  however, 
been  restored;  and  there  are  now  few 
churches  in  England  where  they  are  not 
found.  In  the  East,  the  altar  has  been 
enclosed  by  a  screen  or  an  enclosure  re- 
sembling our  rails,  from  ancient  times. 
These  were  at  first  only  the  cancelli,  or 
KiyKXtSff,  or,  as  Eusebius  styles  them,  re- 
ticulated wood-work.  They  were  after- 
wards enlarged  into  the  holy  doors,  which 
now  wholly  conceal  the  altar,  and  which 
Goar  admits  to  be  an  innovation  of  later 
times,  (pp.  17, 18.)  These  are  not  to  be 
confounded  with  the  enclosure  of  the  choir ; 
which,  like  the  chancel  screen,  was  origin- 
ally very  low,  a  mere  barrier,  but  was 
enlarged  afterwards  into  the  high  screens 
which  now  shut  out  the  choir  from  the 
church. — Jebb's  Choral  Service. 

ALTAR  SCREEN,  now  often  called  a 
Reredos,  though  that  rather  means  some 
ornamental  structure  on  the  screen.  A  screen 
behind  the  altar,  bounding  the  presbytery, 
eastward,  and  in  om-  larger  churches  separa- 
ting it  from  the  parts  left  free  for  processions 
between  the  presbytery  and  the  Lady 
Chapel,  when  the  latter  is  at  the  east  end. 
(See  Cathedral.)  These  screens  were  of 
comparatively  late  invention.  They  com- 
pletely interfered  with  the  ancient  arrange- 
ment of  the  Apsis.  (See  Apsis.)  The  most 
magnificent  specimens  of  altar  screens  are 
in  the  cathedrals  at  Winchester  and  St. 
Alban's.  In  college  chapels,  and  churches 
where  an  apse  would  be  altogether  out  of 
place,  and  where  an  east  window  cannot  be 
inserted,  as  at  New  College,  All  Souls,  and 
Magdalene,  Oxford,  they  are  as  appropriate 
as  they  are  beautiful. — Jebb's  Choral  Service. 

ALTAR  STEPS.  Steps  round  three 
sides  of  the  table  were  pronounced  illegal 
in  Bradford  v.  Fry,  L.  R.  4  Prob.  193. 

AMBO,  or  AMBON  (from  ava  ^alvav,  "  to 
go  up.")  A  kind  of  raised  platform  or  reading 
desk,  from  which,  in  the  primitive  Churchj 
the  Gospel  and  Epistle  were  read  to  the 
people,  and  sometimes  used  in  preaching.  Its 
position  appears  to  have  varied  at  different 
times ;  it  was  most  frequently  on  the  north 
side  of  the  entrance  into  the  chancel. 
Sometimes  there  was  one  on  each  side,  one 
for  the  Epistle,  the  other  for  the  Gospel,  as 
may  still  be  seen  in  the  ancient  churches 
of  St.  Clement  and  St.  Lawrence,  at  Rome, 


AMBROSE 

&c.  The  word  Ambo  has  heen  popularly 
employed  for  a  reading  desk  within  memory, 
as  in  Limerick  cathedral,  where  the  desk 
for  the  lessons  in  the  centre  of  the  choir 
was  so  called.  The  singers  also  had  their 
separate  ambo,  and  in  many  of  the  foreign 
Em'opean  chm-ches  it  is  employed  by  the 
precentor  and  principal  singers;  being 
placed  in  the  middle  of  the  choir,  lilie  an 
■eagle,  but  turned  towards  the  altar. — Jebb's 
<Jhoral  Service.    [H.] 

AMBROSE,  St.,  BISHOP,  and  one  of 
the  four  doctors  of  the  Church.  Commemo- 
rated in  the  English  Calendar  on  April 
4.  He  was  the  governor  of  a  Roman  pro- 
vince, and  while  exercising  his  authority 
in  quelling  some  disturbances  at  the  election 
of  a  bishop  to  the  see  of  Milan,  was  himself, 
by  the  unanimous  voice  of  the  people, 
chosen  bishop.  He  was  at  the  time  only 
a  catechumen,  but  his  nomination  by  the 
people  was  ratified  by  the  secular  and 
ecclesiastical  authorities,  and,  after  being 
baptized,  he  was  presently  consecrated 
"bishop,  being  of  the  age  of  34  (a.d.  374). 
He  at  once  gave  up  all  secular  pursuits,  and 
made  over  all  his  property  to  the  Church. 
Bis  influence  was  very  great,  and  a  remark- 
able instance  of  his  moral  power  was  shown 
by  his  forbidding  the  Emperor  Theodosius 
admittance  to  his  cathedral,  and  partici- 
pation in  the  Holy  Communion,  on  account 
of  his  massacre  of  7000  persons  on  a  trivial 
pretext  at  Thessalonica.  He  introduced 
great  improvements  in  the  conduct  of  public 
worship,  especially  with  regard  to  music. 
The  works  of  St.  Ambrose  now  existing  are 
composed  of  sermons  and  treatises  in  three 
folio  volumes.     He  died  a.d.  397.    [H.] 

AMBROSfAN  RITE.  An  ancient  form 
of  liturgy  retained  at  Milan,  which  derives 
its  name  from  St.  Ambrose,  though  probably 
it  is  even  of  earlier  date.  Attempts  were 
■■made  at  diiferent  times  by  Charlemagne, 
Pope  Pius  v.,  and  Pope  Nicolas  II.,  to 
impose  the  Roman  rite  on  all  churches,  but 
that  of  Milan  sheltered  itself  under  the 
name  and  authority  of  St.  Ambrose,  and 
the  Ambrosian  Ritual  has  continued  in  use. 
It  must  be  added  that  gradual  approaches 
to  the  Roman  ritual  have  been  made, 
though  it  must  stUl  be  considered  a  distinct 
rite.  The  music  connected  with  this  rite 
had  a  very  distinct  character,  like  the 
English  cathedral  music.  It  is  impossible 
to  state  accurately  the  natm-e  and  extent 
of  the  influence  exerted  by  St.  Ambrose 
over  the  music  of  the  Western  Church ;  but 
there  is  no  doubt  that  he  popularized  hymn 
singing  in  the  West,  and  introduced  anti- 
phonal  psalm  chanting.  This  was  used 
for  the  relief  of  the  people  during  their 
night-long  services  at  the  time  of  the  Arian 
•controversy;  and  St.  Augustine  dwells  in 


AMEN 


31 


touching  terms  on  the  effect  produced  on 
himself  at  the  services  at  Milan.  (Conf. 
ix.  7.)  From  Milan  probably  the  anti- 
phonal  system  of  chanting  spread  tlirough 
all  parts  of  V\  estern  Christendom.  Ambrose 
is  said  to  have  learnt  his  system  at  Antioch, 
and  it  is  evidently  of  Greek,  not  Jewish, 
origin.  (See  Gregorians.)  The  Doric, 
Phrygian,  Lydian,  and  Mixo-Lydian  scales 
which  he  used,  being  modifications  of  the 
ancient  Greek  scales,  correspond  to  our 
scales  of  D,  E,  P,  and  G,  only  without 
accidentals.  The  influence  of  St.  Ambrose's 
system  is  evidenced  by  the  fact  that  church 
song  came  to  be  called  generally  "Cantus 
Ambrosianus,"  and  this  may  account  for 
the  "iitle  given  to  the  old  melody  of  the 
"  Te  Deum,"  which  cannot  date  from  such 
early  times.  (See  Te  Deum.') — Dr.  Dykes 
in  Blunt,  P.  B.  Ivii.   [H.] 

AMEDIEU,  or  Friends  of  God.  A  kind 
of  religious  congregation  in  the  Church  of 
Rome,  who  wore  grey  clothes  and  wooden 
shoes,  had  no  breeches,  girding  themselves 
with  a  cord ;  they  began  in  1400,  and  grew 
numerous  ;  but  Pius  V.  united  their  society 
partly  with  that  of  the  Cistercians,  and 
partly  with  the  Soccolanti. 

AMEN.  This,  in  the  phraseology  of  the 
Church,  is  denominated  orationis  sifjnacu- 
lum,  or  devotie  conscionis  responsio,  the 
token  for  prayer — the  response  of  the  wor- 
shippers. It  intimates  that  the  prayer  of 
the  speaker  is  heard,  and  approved  by  him 
who  gives  this  response.  It  is  also  used  at 
the  conclusion  of  a  doxology.  (Rom.  ix.  5.) 
Justin  Martyr  is  the  first  of  the  fathers 
who  speaks  of  the  use  of  the  response.  In 
speaking  of  the  Eucharist  he  says,  that,  at 
the  close  of  the  benediction  and  prayer,  all 
the  assembly  respond,  "Amen,"  which,  in 
the  Hebrew  tongue,  is  the  same  as,  "  So  let 
it  be."  St.  Jerome,  who  lived  in  the  fourth 
century,  tells  us  that  the  Amen  was  pro- 
nounced with  such  heartiness  by  the  jjeople, 
as  to  sound  like  a  clap  of  thunder.  Ac- 
cording to  TertuUian,  none  but  the  faithful 
were  permitted  to  join  in  the  response. 
The  general  meaning  is  "  truly,"  or  "  verily." 
At  the  conclusion  of  a  prayer,  as  the  Cate- 
chism tenches,  it  signifies  so  be  it ;  after 
the  repetition  of  the  Creed  it  means  so  it  is. 
When  in  the  Prayer  Book  the  Amen  is 
printed  in  Roman  characters,  as  at  the  end 
of  the  Lord's  Prayer,  Cimfession,  Creeds, 
&c.,  it  is  to  be  pronounced  by  the  minister 
and  people  together ;  when  printed  in 
italics,  the  Amen  is  to  be  said  by  the  people 
only. 

At  the  reception  of  the  elements  the 
communicants  in  the  ancient  church  always 
said  Amen,  which  custom  is  mentioned  in 
the  Apostolic  Constitutions,  and  by  Cyril, 
TertuUian,    Ambrose,   Augustine,   Jerome, 


32 


AMEKICAN 


and  others.  Bishops  Andrewes,  Sparrow, 
Cosin,  and  Wilson  recommended  it,  but  it 
is  not  enjoined  in  the  English  Liturgy. 
At  the  administration  of  baptism  also,  the 
witnesses  and  sponsors  uttered  this  response 
in  the  same  manner.  In  the  Greek  Church 
It  was  customary  to  repeat  this  response  as 
follows :  "  This  servant  of  the  Lord  is 
baptized  in  the  name  of  the  Father, 
Amen ;  and  of  the  Son,  Amen ;  and  of 
the  Holy  Ghost,  Amen;  both  now  and 
for  ever,  world  without  end;  "  to  which  the 
people  resiionded,  "  Amen."  This  usage  is 
still  observed  by  the  Greek  Church  in 
Eussia.  The  repetitions  were  given  thrice, 
with  reference  to  the  three  Persons  of  the 
Trinity. — Coleman's  Christian  Antiquities. 
AMERICAN  CHUECH.  (See  Church  m 
America.) 

AMERICAN  PEAYBE  BOOK.  After  the 
separation  of  the  North  American  Colonies 
from  England,  it  appeared  likely  that  there 
would  be  endeavours  on  the  part  of  some 
to  introduce  unauthorized  alterations  in  the 
Prayer  Book,  and  that  thus  disorder  might 
spring  up  in  Divine  Worship.  It  was 
therefore  determined  to  draw  up  a  form  of 
Common  Prayer  and  Liturgy,  which  should 
be  national.  The  greatest  care  was  taken, 
and  though  the  first  step  was  made  at  the 
General  Convocation  at  Philadelphia  in 
1785,  it  was  not  till  the  General  Convocation 
in  1789  that  the  Prayer  Book  was  autho- 
rized. There  were  proposals  that  an  en- 
tirely new  book  should  be  prepared,  but 
other  counsels  prevailed,  and  the  Preface 
declares  that  the  American  Church  "  is  far 
from  intending  to  depart  from  the  Church 
of  England,  in  any  essential  point  of 
doctrine,  discipline,  or  worship,  or  farther 
than  local  circumstances  require."  (See 
Church  in  America.') 

Some  of  the  alterations  and  additions  are : 
(1)  The  language  is  in  some  cases  modern- 
ized. (2)  The  Nicene  may  be  used  instead 
of  the  Apostles'  Creed.  (3)  A  rubric  pre- 
faces the  Apostles'  Creed ;  "  and  any  church 
may  omit  the  words  '  He  went  into  Hell,' 
or  may  instead  of  them  use  the  words  '  He 
went  into  the  place  of  departed  spirits.'" 

(4)  The  Athanasian  Creed  is  omitted,  and 
the  Absolution  in  the  Visitation  of  the  Sick. 

(5)  The  priest  may  read  our  Lord's  sum- 
mary of  the  law  (St.  Matt.  xxii.  37)  after 
or  instead  of  the  Ten  Commandments.  (6) 
The  prayer  of  oblation  and  the  invocation 
in  the  Liturgy  are  used  in  immediate 
connexion  with  the  prayer  of  consecration, 
as  in  the  old  liturgies.  (7)  A  selection  of 
psalms  is  appointed  instead  of  our  daily 
order.  (8)  The  words  of  commendation  in 
the  Burial  office  are  slightly  changed.  (9) 
The  words  "  verily  and  indeed  taken ''  are 
changed  to  "  verOy  and  spiritually."    [H.] 


ANABAPTISTS 

AMICE,  The.  (Amictus.)  A  broadish, 
oblong  piece  of  linen,  sometimes  much 
embroidered  and  adorned,  with  two  strings 
to  fasten  it.  When  used  it  is  first  placed 
round  the  head  and  loosely  tied,  then 
slipped  down  and  worn  on  the  shoulders 
beneath  the  alb ;  so  that,  when  in  place,  it 
has  the  appearance  of  an  ornamental  collar. 
(See  "  Rationale  "  Vestments.) 

The  word  amice  is  sometimes  used  with 
greater  latitude.     Thus  Milton  (Par.  Beg. 

" morning  fair 

Came  forth,  with  pilgrim  steps,  in  amice  grey." 

The  grey  amice  would  seem  to  be  the 
almutium,  almuce,  or  aumusse — a  tippet  or 
cape  of  fur.  W.  Gilbert  French,  in  an 
interesting  and  curiously  illustrated  Essay 
on  "  The  Tippets  of  the  Canons  Ecclesi- 
astical," considers  that  there  is  a  distinction 
between  the  amice  and  the  almuce.  The 
former  he  identifies  with  the  definition 
given  above.  The  latter  he  considers  to  be 
the  choir  tippet,  worn  by  all  members  of 
cathedral  churches,  of  materials  varying 
with  the  ecclesiastical  rank  of  the  wearer. 
The  hood  part  of  the  almuce  was  in  the 
course  of  time  disused,  and  a  square  cap 
substituted;  and  the  remaining  parts  gave 
rise  to  the  modern  cape,  worn  in  foreign 
churches,  and  perhaps  the  scarf  now  worn 
by  bishops  and  dignitaries  in  our  Church. 
The  almuce,  or  "aumusse,"  is  now  an 
ornament  of  fur  or  other  materials  carried 
over  the  arm  by  the  canons  of  many  French 
and  other  continental  cathedrals. — Dic- 
tionnaire  de  Droit  Canonique,  1787. 

Cardinal  Bona  only  mentions  the  amictus, 
describing  it  as  in  the  first  paragraph  of 
this  article.  There  seems  nothing  im- 
probable in  the  various  terms  above  men- 
tioned having  been  originally  identical. 
(See  Band,  Hood,  Scarf,  and  Tippet.)  [H.] 
AMPHIBALUM.  (See  OhasiUe.) 
ANABAPTISTS.  Certain  fanatical  sec- 
taries whose  designation  is  derived  from 
the  Greek  ava^ain-L^fiv,  to  baptise  again, 
because  it  was  one  of  their  tenets,  although 
not  the  most  distinctive,  that  persons 
baptized  in  infancy  ought  to  be  baptized 
anew. 

The  first  appearance  of  this  fanatical 
body  was  in  1521,  at  Zwickau,  where  a 
draper  named  Nicholas  Storch  and  other 
enthusiasts,  who  were  called  the  "  prophets 
of  Zwickau,"  began  to  teach:  (1)  That  a 
visible  kingdom  of  Christ  composed  of  none 
but  holy  persons  would  shortly  be  es- 
tablished on  earth.  (2)  That  the  members 
of  this  kingdom  would  be  guided  by  a 
divine  light  within  which  would  place  them 
above  the  elementary  teaching  of  Holy 
Scripture,    and    render    the    restraints    of 


ANABAPTISTS 

human  law,  as  well  as  all  forms  of  religious 
discipline,  unnecessary.  The  practical 
results  of  these  doctrines  were  attempts 
of  the  fiercest  and  wildest  kind  to  over- 
throw all  existing  institutions  in  order  to 
set  up,  as  was  alleged,  the  pure  kingdom  of 
Christ  upon  earth.  The  first  outbreak  was 
connected  with  the  Peasants'  War,  a  rebel- 
lion provoked  by  the  tyrannical  oppressions 
of  the  feudal  nobility.  Under  the  leader- 
ship of  Thomas  Munzer,  the  pastor  of 
Zwickau,  the  revolt  became  a  kind  of 
religious  nihilism  which  raged  over  a  great 
part  of  Gtermany.  It  was  crushed  for  a 
time  by  the  battle  of  Frankenhausen  (May 
15, 1525),  when  the  army  of  the  fanatics 
was  entuely  defeated ;  and  Munzer  having 
been  taken  prisoner,  was  afterwards  exe- 
cuted. 

But  nine  years  later,  in  1534,  there  was 
a  more  fearful  outbreak  of  Anabaptist 
communism,  at  Miinster,  in  Westphalia, 
under  the  leadership  of  Bernard  Eothman, 
the  pastor,  and  two  burghers,  Knechtiug  and 
Knipperdolling.  John  Bockhold,  a  tailor 
of  Leyden,  became  the  head  of  the  society 
under  the  title  of  "King  of  Zion."  His 
deluded  followers  beheld  in  him  the  re- 
presentative of  God  himself,  and  under  him 
the  movement  became  a  revolting  compound 
of  fanaticism  and  sensuality.  For  a  whole 
year  Miinster  was  a  scene  of  appalling  blood- 
shed and  profligacy  carried  on  in  the  name 
of  religion.  The  town  was  taken,  however, 
on  June  24,  1535,  when  John  of  Leyden 
was  executed  after  cruel  torture. 

After  some  short-lived  insurrections  in 
Holland,  the  continental  Anabaptists  aban- 
doned their  efforts  to  establish  their  prin- 
ciples by  violence,  and  under  Menno  of 
Friesland,  who  became  their  leader  about 
the  year  1537,  they  gradually  subsided 
into  a  peaceable,  and  more  rational  commu- 
nity, yet  retaining  to  the  last  some  tinc- 
ture of  fanaticism,  including  the  doctrine 
that  a  Christian  man  ought  not  to  under- 
take the  duties  of  a  secular  functionary. 

In  England  immigrations  of  Anabaptists 
ftom  time  to  time  during  the  sixteenth 
century  caused  considerable  annoyance  and 
some  alarm.  The  first  direct  notice  of  them 
is  in  a  royal  proclamation  issued  in  1534,  in 
which,  certain  strangers  who  in  contempt 
of  the  Holy  Sacrament  of  Baptism  had 
re-baptised  themselves,  are  ordered  to  quit 
the  realm  iu  twelve  days  under  pain  of 
death.  (Wilkins,  Cone.  iii.  779.)  In  1535, 
nineteen  men  and  six  women  (all  from 
Holland),  holding  Anabaptist  opinions,  after 
being  examined  at  St.  Paul's,  were  con- 
demned to  be  burnt.  Throughout  the 
reign  of  Henry  VIII,  rigorous  measures 
were  taken  to  prevent  the  importation  of 
Anabaptist  books,  and  to  enforce  the  ex- 


AMMONIAN 


33 


pulsion  or  execution  of  all  persons  holding 
Anabaptist  opinions.  The  sect  consequently 
made  little  progress  until  the  accession  of 
Edward  VI.,  when  it  rapidly  increased  in 
the  South  of  England,  especially  in  Kent 
and  Essex.  (See  Oriff.  Letters,  Parker  Soc. 
pp.  65,  66,  87.) 

In  Queen  Elizabeth's  reign  on  three 
different  occasions,  all  persons,  whether 
foreigners  or  natives,  who  were  Anabaptists, 
were  ordered  to  leave  the  kingdom  under 
the  severest  penalties.  But  neither  argu- 
ment nor  terror  could  subdue  their  obstinacy, 
and  Peeters  and  Turwert,  and  several  others, 
were  burnt  at  the  stake.  The  last  execution 
of  Anabaptists  in  England  was  in  1575.  At 
the  beginning  of  the  Protectorate  the  Ana- 
baptists, under  Harrison,  had  great  power, 
and  deemed  themselves  called  by  God  to 
prepare  the  way  for  the  reign  of  Christ  with 
His  saints  upon  earth.  But  their  aggressive 
fanaticism  bringing  them  under  the  dis- 
pleasure of  Cromwell,  he  reduced  them  "  to 
their  original  nothing."  In  1658  the  Ana- 
baptists sent  an  address  to  King  Charles  II., 
together  with  five  propositions  with  regard 
to  parliaments,  regal  authority,  liberty  of 
conscience,  tithes  and  amnesty  of  all 
political  offenders.  The  king  returned  a 
general  answer,  and  expressed  himself 
"willing  to  confer  with  some  persons  of 
that  party,"  at  Bruges.  (Clar.  Hist.  bk. 
XV. ;  Lingard,  viii.  151 ;  xi.  9  ;  Collier,  iv. 
283 ;  vi.  332.  For  general  history  of  the 
sect  see  Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  vol. 
iii.  pp.  136-144;  Hardwick's  History  of 
the  Beformation,  pp.  252-258;  Blunt's 
Dictionary  of  Sects.)  Allusion  is  made  to 
this  sect  in  the  39th  Article,  but  neither 
community  of  goods,  nor  tenets  subversive 
of  civil  government,  are  now  held  by  the 
Anabaptists,  or  Baptists.  See  Baptists.)  [H.] 
AMMONIAN  SECTIONS.  In  the  middle 
of  the  third  century  Ammonius,  an  Egyptian 
monk,  divided  the  Gospels  into  sections,  in 
order  that  he  might  construct  a  Harmony,  in 
which  the  four  narratives  of  the  Evangelists 
might  be  continued.  He  took  St.  Matthew 
as  the  normal  Gospel,  divided  it  into 
sections,  and  then  arranged  against  it,  in 
parallel  colunms,  the  corresponding  portions 
of  the  other  Gospels.  The  mmibers  which 
denote  these  Ammonian  sections  are  often 
found  in  the  margin  of  the  MSS.  of  the 
Greek  Testament. 

In  the  following  century  Eusebius  drew 
up  the  Tables  which  are  commonly  called 
his  Canons.  In  these  the  Ammonian  sec- 
tions are  so,  distributed  as  to  show  in  a 
tabular  form  what  portions  of  the  other 
Evangelists  correspond  to  that  Gospel 
which  stands  first  in  order  in  each  canon. 
The  numbers  of  the  canons  were  subjoined 
by  Eusebius  to  the  Ammonian  sections, 

s 


34 


ANAPHORA 


as  they  stood  in  the  margin  of  a  Greek 
copy  of  the  Gospels;  hence  they  hecame 
generally  known  and  used.  In  some  MSS. 
they  appear  as  placed  by  Eusebius;  in 
others,  the  Ammonian  sections  alone  are 
to  he  found  in  the  margin  ;  while  at  the 
foot  of  the  page  those  numbers  are  repeated 
with  a  short  table  of  the  sections  in  the 
other  Gospels  which  correspond. — "Words- 
worth's Ok.  Test.  vol.  ii.,  xxvii.  xxviii. 
(See  Diatessaron. :  Eusebius'  Canons.)   [H.] 

ANAPHOEA.(aj/a(/)opa,araisLngup.)The 
most  solenm  portion  of  the  Eastern  Liturgy, 
beginning  with  the  "Sursum  Corda,"  and 
including  the  Prayer  of  Consecration.  The 
old  Liturgies  are  all  divisible  into  two  main 
parts — the  Pro-Anaphora,  and  the  Ana- 
phora ;  and  the  latter  was  divided  into  (1) 
the  great  Eucharistic  prayer ;  (2)  the  Con- 
secration ;  (3)  the  great  Intercession;  (4) 
the  Communion.  The  Anaphora  is  repre- 
sented in  our  English  office  by  the  part 
which  begins  with  the  versicle  "Lift  up 
your  hearts." 

ANATHEMA  {ava6eij.a\  to  be  dis- 
tinguished from  Anathema  (dvddrjfui),  both, 
indeed,  meaning  something  set  apart  or 
devoted  to  God;  but  the  former  for  evil, 
the  latter  for  good,  as  with  regard  to 
votive  offerings,  &c.  (St.  Luke  xxi.  5).  The 
word  anathema,  as  in  1  Cor.  xvi.  22,  is 
generally  used  to  express  the  cutting  off 
of  a  person  from  the  communion  of  the 
faithful.  It  was  practised  in  the  primitive 
Church  against  notorious  offenders.  Se- 
veral councils,  also,  have  pronounced  ana- 
themas against  such  as  they  thought  cor- 
rupted the  purity  of  the  faith.  The  Church 
of  England  in  her  18th  Article  anathema- 
tizes those  who  teach  that  eternal  salva- 
tion is  to  be  obtained  otherwise  than 
through  the  name  of  Christ,  and  in  her 
Canons  excommunicates  aU  who  say  that 
the  Church  of  England  is  not  a  true  and 
apostolic  Church. — Can.  3.  All  impugners 
of  the  public  worship  of  God,  established 
in  the  Church  of  England. — Can.  4.  All 
impugners  of  the  rites  and  ceremonies  of 
the  Church. — Can.  6.  All  impugners  of 
episcopacy. — Can.  7.  All  authors  of  schism. 
— Can.  9.  All  maintainers  of  schismatics. — 
Can.  10.  AU  these  persons  lie  under  the 
anathema  of  the  Church  of  England.  (See 
Excommunication.') 

ANALOGY  OP  FAITH,  [translated  in 
our  version,  proportion  of  faith,']  is  the 
proportion  or  proper  relation  that  the  doc- 
trines of  the  Gospel  bear  to  each  other. 
(Rom.  xii.  6.) 

Aristotle  defines  avhXoyia  as  laorris  Xdyoji/, 
equality  of  ratios  (Eth.  N.  v.  iii.  8),  and 
hence  comes  our  use  of  the  word  as  signify- 
ing proportion.  All  things  are  to  be  done 
in  the  Church  with  a  constant  regard  to 


ANDBEWS 

this  law  of  'Ai/aXoyia,  or  proportion.  Scrip- 
ture, that  is  to  say,  is  to  be  expounded  (1) 
not  according  to  men's  private  notions,  nor 
(2)  from  one  or  two  texts  or  chapters  taken 
singly  and  by  themselves ;  but  (3)  accord- 
ing to  the  general  harmony  of  the  whole 
body  of  Christian  doctrine — the  Eegula 
Fidei.  It  has  always  been  the  charac- 
teristic of  heretics  to  Interpret  the  words  of 
Scripture  piecemeal,  without  regard  to  the 
tenor  of  the  whole.  Against  this  St.  Peter 
gives  warning  (2  Pet.  iii.  16);  and  the 
warning  has  been  repeated  by  divines  in 
all  ages  of  the  Church.  (Tert.  Prxscr. 
JTssret.  cvi.  p.  440,  Oxf.  Tr.  and  elsewhere ; 
Iren.  i.  19 ;  Augustine,  Joann.  Tract  18, 
and  elsewhere ;  Cranmer  in  Htformatio 
Legum,  i.  13 ;  Andrewes,  v.  57 ;  Waterland, 
vol.  V.  pp.  265  seq. ;  &c.  &c.)  "  It  is  there- 
fore a  happy  characteristic  of  the  Church  of 
England  that  she  reads  the  whole  of  the 
New  Testament,  and  a  great  part  of  the 
Old,  publicly  to  her  congregation,  and  thus 
endeavours  to  protect  her  clergy  and  her 
people  against  the  danger  of  dwelling  ex- 
clusively on  particular  texts,  and  directs 
them  to  interpret  each  several  portion  of 
Scripture  'according  to  the  proportion  of 
the  Faith,'  as  displayed  in  the  whole  Bible." 
— Wordsworth's  Qh.  Test.,  Eom.  xii.  6. 

ANCHORET  or  ANCHORITE,  from 
avaxoipuv,  to  withdraw.  A  name  given  to  a 
hermit,  from  his  dwelUng  alone,  apart  from 
society.  The  anchoret  is  distinguished  from 
the  coenobite,  or  the  monk  who  dwells  in 
a  fraternity,  or  Koii/o'/3ia.  According  to 
Cursian,  the  anchorets  were  derived  from 
the  coenobites,  who  were  the  descendants 
of  those  who  at  Jerusalem  "  had  aU  things 
conunon."  (Curs.  Collab.  xviii.  5.)  St.  Paul 
and  St.  Anthony  are  claimed  as  the  first 
anchorites. — Bingham,  vii.  2  ;  Newman's 
Fleury,  xx.  5.     (See  Monhs ;  Cmnohites.) 

ANDREW'S  DAT,  ST. :  Apostle.  Cele- 
brated by  the  Church  of  England,  Nov. 
30.  After  the  Ascension  of  Christ,  when 
the  apostles  distributed  themselves  in 
various  parts  of  the  world,  St.  Andrew  is 
said  to  have  preached  the  gospel  in  Scythia, 
in  Bpirus,  in  Cappadocia,  Galatia,  Bithy- 
nia,  and  the  vicinity  of  Byzantium,  and 
finally,  to  have  suffered  death  by  cruci- 
fixion at  Patrse,  in  Achaia,  by  order  of 
the  proconsul.  The  instrument  of  his 
death  is  said  to  have  been  in  the  form  of 
the  letter  X,  being  a  cross  decussate,  or 
saltier,  two  pieces  of  timber  crossing  each 
other  in  the  middle;  and  hence  usually 
known  by  the  name  of  St.  Andrew's 
cross. 

This  festival  is  one  of  those  for  which  an 
epistle  and  gospel  are  provided  in  the 
Lectionary  of  St.  Jerome,  and  which  has 
also  prayers  appointed  for  it  in  the  Sacra- 


ANGEL 

mentary  of  Gregory.  It  is  therefore  of  very 
ancient  date  in  the  Church. 

ANGEL  (ayyfXoy),  a  messenger.  I. 
Those  who  were  appointed  by  the  Apostles 
as  chief  overseers  of  the  churches  in  pro- 
vinces and  principal  cities  were  first  some- 
times called  Angels,  probably  owing  to  this 
designation  being  given  to  the  presidents 
of -the  Seven  Churches.  It  is  not  impro- 
bable that  the  Apostolical  Bishops  may 
have  been  called  Angels,  as  ministering  the 
New  Testament,  with  reference  to  the  fact 
of  the  law  having  been  received  by  the  dis- 
position of  angels  (Acts  vii.  53 ;  Gal.  iii. 
19 ;  Heb.  ii.  12),  and  of  our  Lord  being 
called  the  Angel  of  the  presence  (Isa.  Ixiii. 
9),  and  of  the  covenant  (Matt.  iii.  1 ;  Psa. 
Ixviii.  8 ;  Numb.  xx.  16 ;  Bxod.  xxxii. 
34 ;  xxxiii.  2) ;  and  St.  Paul  says  that 
the  Gralatians  received  him  as  an  "  angel  of 
God"  (Gal.  iv.  14).  The  name  did  not 
last,  and  the  three  orders  of  Bishops, 
Priests,  and  Deacons,  were  determined  and 
distinguished  nominally,  as  in  fact  they  had 
always  been  recognised.  (St.  Hieron.  Epist. 
c.  1.  ad  Evang.,  and  Comm.  in  Ep.  ad 
Tit.  c.  1;  St.  Cypr.  Ep.  Iv.  See  Introd.  to 
the  Ordinal,  Blunt,  P.  B.  p.  531.) 

n.  But  the  word  is  generally  applied  to 
those  spiritual  beings  who  surround  the 
throne  of  glory,  and  who  are  sent  forth  to 
minister  to  them  that  be  heirs  of  salvation. 
It  is  supposed  by  some  that  there  is  a 
subordination  of  angels  in  heaven,  in  the  se- 
veral ranks  of  seraphim,  cherubim,  thrones, 
dominions,  principalities,  &c.  We  recog- 
nise in  the  service  of  the  Chmrch  the  three 
orders  of  archangels,  cherubim,  and  sera- 
phim. Two  archangels  are  named  in  the 
prophecy  of  Daniel,  Michael  and  Gabriel, 
who  are  also  mentioned  in  the  New  Testa- 
ment. In  the  book  of  Tobit,  the  probable 
date  of  which  is  about  350  e.g.,  Eaphael 
describes  himself  as  one  of  the  seven  holy 
angels,  which  present  the  prayers  of  the 
saints,  and  go  in  and  out  before  the  glory 
of  the  Holy  One.  The  ofiBce  of  the  arch- 
angels appears  to  be  (1)  the  ruling  of 
the  whole  angelical  host ;  (2)  the  peculiar 
charge  and  guardianship  of  the  Church. 
<See  Pusey,  Banid,  pp.  513,  522.)  Of  the 
two  other  orders  of  angels,  the  cherubim 
are  mentioned  as  forbidding  the  approach 
to  Eden ;  as  covering  the  ark  ;  as  in  imme- 
diate attendance  on  the  Almighty  (Ezek. 
X.).  The  seraphim  appear  only  in  the 
vision  of  Isaiah.  They  are  spirits  of  fire 
(the  word  in  the  Hebrew  signifying  to 
burn),— the  fire  of  love.  They  are  engaged 
in  ceaseless  praise,  yet  are  sent  to  minister 
to  us  below,  for  they  touched  the  pro- 
phet's lips  with  a  coal  of  fire  from  the 
altar.  It  is  possible  that  these  two  orders 
oi  angels  are  alluded  to  in  Psa.  civ.  4,  "  He 


ANGELICI 


35 


maketh  his  angels  spirits ;  and  his  ministers 
a  flaming  fire." 

HI.  The  worship  of  angels  as  mediators 
between  God  and  man  was  a  fonii  of 
Gnostic  error  against  which  St.  Paul  warns 
the  Colossians  (Col.  ii.  18),  as  incompatible 
with  a  right  belief  in  the  mediatorial  oflice  of 
Christ.  It  is  clear,  however,  that  it  lingered 
amongst  the  Churches  of  Asia  Minor,  for 
in  the  middle  of  the  fourth  century  it  was  . 
condemned  by  the  Council  of  Laodicea  in 
the  following  terms  (35th  Canon) :  "  Chris- 
tians ought  not  to  forsake  the  Church  of 
God,  and  depart  and  call  on  angels,  and 
make  meetings,  which  are  forbidden.  If 
any  one,  therefore,  be  found,  giving  him- 
self to  this  hidden  idolatry,  let  him  be 
anathema,  because  he  hath  left  the  Lord 
Jesus  Christ,  the  Son  of  God,  and  hath 
betaken  himself  to  idolatry!'  The  same 
principle  applies  to  prayers  made  to  any 
created  being,  and  is  therefore  a  condemna- 
tion of  the  Romish  practice  of  invoking  saints 
as  well  as  angels.  The  worship  of  the  crea- 
ture was  regarded  by  the  Church  in  the 
foujth  century  as  idolatry.  See  Bishop 
Beveridge's  Expos,  of  Acts  xxii. :  see  also 
Bishop  Bull,  on  the  Corruption  of  the 
Church  of  Rome,  sect,  iii.,  who,  whilst 
showing  that  the  ancient  fathers  and  coim- 
cils  were  express  in  their  denunciation  of 
it,  (e.g.  the  Council  of  Laodicea,  Theo- 
doret,  Origen,  Justin  Martyr,  &c.,)  says, 
"  It  is  very  evident  that  the  Catholic  Chris- 
tians of  Origen's  time  made  no  prayers  to 
angels  or  saints,  but  directed  all  their 
prayers  to  God,  through  the  alone  media- 
tion of  Jesus  Christ  our  Savioiu-.  Indeed, 
against  the  invocation  of  angels  and  saints 
we  have  the  concurrent  testimonies  of  all 
the  Catholic  Fathers  of  the  first  three  cen- 
turies at  least."  Bishop  Bull  then  refers  to 
his  own  Bef.  Fid.  Nic.  ii.,  for  a  refuta- 
tion of  Bellarmine's  unfair  citation  of  Justin 
Martyr,  (Apol.  i.  6,  p.  47,)  where  he  says, 
"  I  have  evidently  proved  that  that  plan  of 
Justin,  so  far  from  giving  countenance  to 
the  religious  worship  of  angels,  makes  di- 
rectly against  it."  For  the  adoration  paid 
to  angels  in  Gregory's  time  see  Miknan's 
Laf.  Christ,  vol.  i.  p.  437.     [H.] 

ANGELIC  HYMN.  A  title  given  to 
the  hymn  or  doxology  begiuning  with 
"  Glory  be  to  God  on  high,"  &c.  It  is  so 
called  from  the  former  part  of  it  having 
been  sung  by  the  angels  on  their  appear- 
ance to  the  shepherds  of  Bethlehem,  to 
announce  to  them  the  birth  of  the  Re- 
deemer.    (See  Gloria  in  Excelsis.) 

ANGBLICI  or  ANGELICS.  1.  A  very 
ancient  sect  whose  name  was  derived  either 
from  their  paying  excessive  reverence  to 
angels,  or  from  their  maintaining  that  the 
world  was  created  by  angels.     They  were 

D  2 


36 


ANGELITES 


supposed  to  have  their  rise  in  the  Apostles' 
time,  but  were  most  numerous  about  a.d. 
180.  2.  A  congregation  of  nuns  founded 
at  Milan  in  1534. 

ANGELITES.  A  name  assumed  by  the 
Alexandrian  Jacobites,  who  called  their 
church,  erected  a.d.  540,  Angelium.  Nice- 
phorus  {Hist.  Ecdes.  xviii.  49)  asserts  that 
they  held  tritheistio  opinions;  but  others 
say  they  held  that  there  is  but  one  Person 
in  the  Godhead— Broughton's  BMio.,  vol.  i. 

p.  49. 

ANGELUS.  A  form  of  prayer,  re- 
hearsed three  times  a  day  at  the  sound  of 
a  bell  rung  for  the  purpose,  and  called  the 
antrelus  bell.  The  service  consisted  of  three 
antiphons,  each  followed  by  the  angelic 
salutation  (St.  Luke  i.  28,  42).  It  is  of 
mediaeval  origin,  and  is  never  used  in  Eng- 
land. 

ANGLO-CATHOLIC  CHURCH.  (See 
Church  of  England.) 

ANNATES,  or  PIEST-PEUITS.  The 
first  year's  income  of  newly  appointed  arch- 
bishops and  bishops  exacted  by  the  pope 
before  he  would  confirm  the  election,  upon 
a  pretence  originally  of  defending  Christen- 
dom from  the  infidels.  Afterwards  the  pope 
prevailed  on  all  those  who  were  spiritual 
patrons  to  oblige  their  clerks  to  pay  these 
annates ;  and  so  by  degrees  they  became  pay- 
able by  the  clergy  in  generaL  Some  of  our 
historians  tell  us  that  Pope  Clement  V.  was 
the  first  who  claimed  annates  in  England,  in 
the  reign  of  Edward  I. ;  but  Selden,  in  a 
short  account  which  he  has  given  us  of  the 
reign  of  William  Eufus,  afBrms  that  they 
were  claimed  by  the  pope  before  that  reign. 
Chronologers  differ  also  about  the  time 
when  they  became  a  settled  duty.  Platina 
asserts  that  Boniface  IX.,  who  was  pope  in 
the  first  year  of  Henry  IV.,  Annatarum 
usum,  beneficiis  ecdesiasficis  primum  im- 
posuit  (viz.)  dimidium  annul  proventus 
fisco  apostolico  persolvere.  Walsingham 
affirms  it  to  be  above  eighty  years  before 
that  time,  viz.  in  the  time  of  Pope  John 
XXII.,  who  was  pope  about  the  middle  of 
the  reign  of  Edward  II.,  and  that  he  re- 
servavit  camerae  suce  primos  fructus  hene- 
ficiorum.  The  truth  would  seem  to  be  that 
the  old  and  accustomed  fees  paid  here  to  the 
feudal  lords  were  called  heneficia ;  and  that 
the  popes,  assuming  to  be  lords  or  spiritual 
heads  of  the  Church,  were  not  contented  with 
an  empty  though  very  great  title,  without 
some  temporal  advantage,  and  therefore 
Boniface  VIII.,  about  the  latter  end  of  the 
reign  of  Edward  I.,  having  assumed  an 
absolute  dominion  in  beneficiary  matters, 
made  himself  a  kind  of  feudal  lord  over  the 
benefices  of  the  Church,  and  as  a  conse- 
quence thereof,  claimed  a  year's  profits  of 
the  Chiuch,  as  a  beneficiary  fee  due  to 


ANNATES 

himself,  the  chief  lord.  But  though  the 
usurped  power  of  the  pope  was  then  very 
great,  the  king  and  the  people  did  not 
comply  with  this  demand ;  insomuch  that, 
by  the  statute  of  Carlisle,  which  w;as  made 
in  the  last  year  of  his  reign,  and  about  the 
beginning  of  the  popedom  of  Clement  V., 
this  was  called  a  new  imposition  gravis  e( 
intolerahilis,  et  contra  leges  et  consuetudine^ 
regni ;  and  by  reason  of  this  powerful  op- 
position the  matter  rested  for  some  time  : 
but  the  successors  of  that  pope  fovmd  more- 
favourable  opportunities  to  insist  on  this 
demand,  which  was  a  year's  profits  of  each 
vacant  bishopric,  at  a  reasonable  valuation, 
viz.  a  moiety  of  the  full  value :  and  having 
obtained  what  they  demanded,  they  after- 
wards endeavoured  to  raise  the  value,  but 
were  opposed  in  this  likewise  by  the  parlia- 
ment, in  the  6th  of  Henry  IV.,  and  a 
penalty  was  inflicted  on  those  bishops  who- 
paid  more  for  their  first-fruits  than  was- 
accustomed.  But,  notwithstanding  these 
statutes,  such  was  the  plenitude  of  the 
pope's  power,  and  so  great  was  the  profit 
which  accrued  to  him  by  this  invention,, 
that  in  little  more  than  half  a  century,  the 
sum  of  £16,000  was  paid  to  him,  under  the- 
name  of  annates,  for  expediting  bulls  of 
bishoprics  only.  The  payment  of  these 
was  continued  till  about  the  25th  year  of 
Henry  VIII.,  and  then  an  act  was  made, 
reciting,  that  since  the  beginning  of  that 
parliament  another  statute  had  been  made  , 
(which  act  is  not  printed)  for  suppress- 
ing the  exaction  of  annates  of  archbishops- 
and  bishops.  But  the  parliament  being 
unwUling  to  proceed  to  extremities,  re- 
mitted the  putting  that  act  in  execution 
to  the  king  himself;  that  if  the  pope  would, 
either  put  down  annates,  or  so  moderate 
the  payment  that  they  might  no  longer  be 
a  burthen  to  the  people,  the  king,  by  letters 
patent,  might  declare  the  act  should  be  of 
no  force. 

The  pope,  having  notice  of  this,  and 
taking  no  care  to  reform  those  exactions,, 
that  statute  was  confirmed ;  and  because  it 
only  extended  to  annates  paid  for  arch- 
bishoprics and  bishoprics,  in  the  next  year 
another  statute  was  made  (26  Henry  VIIL. 
cap.  3),  that  not  only  those  first-fruits  for- 
merly paid  by  bishops,  but  those  of  every 
other  spiritual  living,  should  be  paid  to 
the  king.  Notwithstanding  these  laws, 
there  were  still  some  apprehensions,  that, 
upon  the  death  of  several  prelates  who- 
were  then  very  old,  great  sums  of  money 
would  be  conveyed  to  Eome  by  their  suc- 
cessors ;  therefore.  Anno  33  Henry  VIII., 
it  was  enacted,  that  all  contributions  of" 
annates  for  bishoprics,  or  for  any  buUs  to 
be  obtained  from  the  see  of  Eome,  should, 
cease;  and  if  the  pope  should  deny  any 


ANNATES 

iulls  of  consecration  by  reason  of  this  pro- 
hibition, then  the  bishop  presented  should 
be  consecrated  in  England  by  the  arch- 
bishop of  the  province ;  and  if  it  was 
the  case  of  an  archbishop,  then  he  should 
be  consecrated  by  any  two  bishops  to  be 
appointed  by  the  king;  and  that,  instead 
of  annates,  a  bishop  should  pay  to  the 
pope  £5  per  cent,  of  the  clear  yearly  value 
of  his  bishopric.  But  before  this  time 
(viz.  31  Henry  VIII.  cap.  22)  there  was 
a  court  erected  by  the  parliament,  for  the 
levjdng  and  government  of  these  first- 
fruits,  which  court  was  dissolved  by  Queen 
Mary ;  and  in  the  next  year  the  payment 
was  ordered  to  cease  as  to  her.  But  in  the 
first  of  Elizabeth  they  were  again  restored 
±0  the  crown,  and  the  statute  32  Hen. 
VIII.,  which  directed  the  grant  and  order 
of  them,  was  recontinued ;  and  that  they 
-should  be  from  thenceforth  within  the 
goverrunent  of  the  exchequer.  But  vicar- 
ages not  exceeding  £10  per  annum,  and 
parsonages  not  exceeding  ten  marks,  ac- 
cording to  the  valuation  in  the  first-fruits' 
•office,  were  exempted  from  payment  of 
first-fruits.  By  the  before-mentioned  sta- 
tute, a  new  officer  was  created,  called  a 
remembrancer  of  the  first-fruits,  whose 
business  it  was  to  take  compositions  for 
the  same;  and 'to  send  process  to  the 
■sheriff  against  those  who  did  not  pay  it; 
and  by  the  Act  26  Henry  VIII.  he  who 
^entered  into  a  living  without  compounding, 
■or-  paying  the  first-fruits,  was  to  forfeit 
double  the  value. 

Queen  Anne,  taMng  into  consideration 
±he  insufficient  maintenance  of  the  poor 
clergy,  sent  a  message  to  the  House  of 
Commons  by  one  of  her  principal  secre- 
taries, signifying  her  intention  to  grant  the 
first-fruits  for  the  better  support  of  the 
clergy ;  and  that  they  would  find  out  some 
means  to  make  her  intentions  more  effectual. 
Thereupon  an  act  was  passed,  by  which  the 
queen  was  to  incorporate  persons,  and  to 
settle  upon  them  and  their  successors  the 
revenue  of  the  first-fruits;  but  that  the 
statutes  before  mentioned  should  continue 
in  force,  for  such  intents  and  purposes  as 
should  be  directed  in  her  grant ;  and  that 
this  new  act  should  not  extend  to  impeach 
or  make  void  any  former  grant  naade  of 
this  revenue.  And  likewise  any  person, 
except  infants  and  femmes- coverts,  without 
their  husbands,  might,  by  bargain  and  sale 
enrolled,  dispose  lands  or  goods  to  such 
corporation,  for  the  maintenance  of  the 
clergy  officiating  in  the  Established  Church, 
without  any  settled  competent  provision ; 
and  the  corporation  might  also  purchase 
lands  for  that  purpose,  notwithstanding  the 
statute  of  mortmain. 

Many  acts  relating  thereto  have  since  been 


ANNEXKD 


37 


passed,  which  will  more  properly  oe  noticed 
under  Qtieen  Anne's  Bounty. 

ANNEXED  BOOK  OP  COMMON 
PRAYER,  The.  The  copy  of  the  revised 
Book  of  Common  Prayer  which  was  attached 
or  annexed  to  he  Act  of  Uniformity  in  1661, 
and  is  referred  to  in  it  as  "  the  book  annexed 
and  joyned  to  this  present  Act."  This 
Annexed  Book  was  for  many  years  supposed 
to  have  been  lost,  but  a  special  search 
having  been  made  in  the  year  1867,  soon 
after  the  "  Royal  Commissioners  appointed 
to  inquire  into  the  Rubrics,"  &c.,  began 
their  labours,  it  was  discovered  in  the  Public 
Record  Office.  The  book  is  in  manuscript 
contained  in  544  pages  of  stout  writing 
paper,  bound  with  leather.  There  are  six 
small  holes  along  the  back,  through  which 
the  strings  whereby  it  was  attached  to  the 
act  were  passed,  the  ends  of  the  strings 
being  still  visible,  and  in  the  roll  of  parch- 
ment on  which  the  act  is  written,  there  are 
also  six  holes  corresponding  exactly  with 
those  which  are  traceable  on  the  back  of  the 
Annexed  Book.  At  the  end  of  the  volume 
are  three  leaves  containing  the  signatures  of 
the  members  of  the  two  houses  of  Convoca- 
tion in  the  Province  of  Canterbury.  These 
occupy  five  pages,  and  are  followed  by  the 
signatures  of  the  Convocation  of  York,  which 
cover  one  page. 

The  discovery  of  this  book  has  rather  an 
important  bearing,  which  has  been  very 
commonly  overlooked,  on  the  interpretation 
of  the  much-disputed  "  Ornaments  Rubric." 
As  in  one  of  the  English  Printed  "  Sealed 
Books,"  and  the  Irish  MS.  copy,  this  rubric 
is  omitted,  it  was  maintained  by  some 
persons  that  there  was  reason  to  suspect 
that  it  was  an  unauthorised  interpolation. 
This  theory  is  completely  disposed  of  by 
the  fact  that  the  rubric  in  question  is  con- 
tained in  the  Book  "  Annexed  "  to  the  Act 
of  Uniformity.  And  it  is  to  be  observed 
that  the  words  of  the  rubric  are  an  exact 
transcript  from  the  Act  of  Uniformity 
passed  in  the  second  year  of  Elizabeth,  1559, 
but  the  clause  which  follows  in  that  act 
"  until  other  order  shall  be  therein  taken," 
which  has  been  supposed  to  give  the  act 
only  a  provisional  force,  is  omitted.  The 
"  Annexed  Book  "  being  attached  to  the  Act 
of  Uniformity,  is  really  an  integral  part  of 
that  act,  and  it  thus  appears  that  the 
rubric  in  question  was  simply  transferred 
from  the  Act  of  1559  to  the  Act  of  1661, 
the  additional  clause,  which  seems  to  give  a 
provisional  character  to  the  earlier  of  these 
two  acts,  being  deliberately  omitted.  It 
follows  that  whatever  force  may  havt  re- 
sided in  this  clause  during  the  reign  of 
Elizabeth,  James  I.  or  Charles  I.,  was  can- 
celled when  the  Act  of  1661  was  passed,  in 
which  the  directions  immediately  preceding 


38 


ANNE 


the  clause  are  repeated  wHle  the  clause 
itself  is  omitted.  The  order  concerning 
"the  ornaments  of  the  church  and  the 
ministers  thereof,"  which  had  been  pro- 
visional, was  now  made  absolute,  and  there- 
fore to  lay  any  stress  upon  the  Advertise- 
ments of  1564  or  the  Canons  of  1604,  in 
the  interpretation  of  this  order,  appears 
to  be  altogether  beside  the  question.— 
[W.  E.  W.  S.]  But  the  Privy  Council  re- 
jected that  view,  in  the  Purchas  and  the 
Eidsdale  cases.     [Gr.] 

ANNE,  St.,  commemorated  in  the  English 
Calendar,  July  26, — the  Mother  of  the 
Blessed  Virgin  Mary,  and  wife  of  Joachim. 
She  is  not  mentioned  in  Scripture,  but  was 
doubtless  honoured  ia  the  primitive  Church 
as  the  parent  of  the  Mother  of  our  Lord, 
and  her  figure  with  her  name  attached  is 
often  found  in  the  Catacombs,  but  the 
earliest  writer  who  mentions  her  is  Epi- 
phanius  (a.d.  368).  Justinian  built  a 
church  at  Constantinople  in  honour  of  St. 
Anne  about  550.     [H.] 

ANNOTINE  BASTBB.  The  day  on 
which  the  primitive  Christians  commemo- 
rated their  baptism.  Low  Sunday,  or  the 
octave  of  Easter,  seems  to  have  been  the 
usual  day  (see  Low  Sunday) ;  but  sometimes 
the  fourth  Sunday  after  Easter  was  thus 
observed,  while  in  the  Lectionary  of  St. 
Jerome  the  Pascha  Annotinum  is  set  down 
for  the  third  Sunday. — Micrologus  Ivi., 
quoted  by  Blunt,  Dictionary  of  Theology, 
p.  25 ;   Annot.  P.  B.  p.  107.    [H.] 

ANNIVELAIS,  or  Annualais.  The 
chantry  priests,  whose  duty  it  was  to  say 
private  masses  at  particular  altars,  were  so 
called ;  as  at  Exeter  Cathedral,  &o.  They 
were  also  called  chaplains.  (See  AnnuaZia.) 
ANNUALIA.  1.  Oblation  anciently 
made  by  relations  of  a  deceased  person  on 
the  anniversary  of  the  death,  when  mass 
was  celebrated  with  great  solemnity.  2. 
The  priest's  salary  for  celebrating  mass 
annually. 

ANNUNCIADAor  ANNUNTIATA.  A 
denomination  common  to  several  orders. 
(1)  A  religious  order  instituted  in  1232 
by  seven  Florentine  merchants.  (2)  A 
military  order  founded  by  Amadeus  VI., 
duke  of  Savoy.  (3)  A  society  founded  at 
Eome,  in  the  year  1460,  by  Cardinal  John 
Turrecremata,  for  the  marrying  of  poor 
maids.  It  now  bestows,  every  Lady-day, 
sixty  Eoman  crowns,  a  suit  of  white  serge, 
and  a  florin  for  slippers,  to  above  400  maids 
for  their  portion.  The  popes  have  so  great 
a  regard  for  this  charitable  foundation,  that 
they  make  a  cavalcade,  attended  with  the 
cardinals,  &c.,  to  distribute  tickets  for  these 
sixty  crowns,  &c.,  to  those  selected  to 
receive  them.  If  any  of  the  maids  are 
desirous  to  be  nuns,  they  have  each  of  them 


ANOINTING- 

120  cro^vns,  and  are  distinguished  by  a 
chaplet  of  flowers  on  their  head.  (4)  A 
Popish  order  of  women,  foxmded  by  Queen 
Joan,  of  France,  after  her  divorce  from 
Lewis  XII.,  whose  rule  and  chief  business 
was  to  honour,  with  a  great  many  beads 
and  rosaries,  the  ten  principal  virtues  or 
delights  of  the  Virgin  Mary;  the  first  of 
which  they  make  to  be  when  the  angel 
Gabriel  annunciated  to  her  the  mystery  of 
the  incarnation,  from  whence  they  have 
their  name;  the  second,  when  she  saw  her 
son  Jesus  brought  into  the  world;  the 
third,  when  the  wise  men  came  to  worship 
him ;  the  fourth,  when  she  found  him  dis- 
puting with  the  doctors  in  the  temple,  &o. 
This  order  was  confirmed  by  the  pope  in 
1501,  and  by  Leo  X.  again  in  1517.  It 
was  also  called  the  Order  of  the  Ten  Virtues, 
or  Delights,  of  the  Virgin  Mary.  (5)  A 
nunnery  founded  by  a  Genoese  lady  in 
1600. 

ANNUNCIATION  of  the  BLESSED 
VIEGIN  MAEY.  (1)  This  festival  is  ap- 
pointed by  the  Church,  in  commemoration 
of  that  day  on  which  it  was  announced  to 
Mary,  by  an  angel,  that  she  should  be 
the  mother  of  the  Messiah.  (2)  The 
observance  of  this  festival  is  of  great  an- 
tiquity, though  it  is  not  mentioned  in  the 
Lectionary  of  St.  Jerome.  There  is  a 
collect  for  the  day  in  both  the  sacramentaries 
of  Gelasius  (a.d.  492)  and  St.  Gregory 
(a.d.  590).  A  homily  written  on  it  by 
Proclus,  patriarch  of  Constantinople  in  the 
fifth  century,  is  still  extant.  At  the  Council 
of  Toledo  (a.d.  656),  the  date  of  the  festival 
was  changed  to  December  18,  so  that  it 
should  never  occur  during  Lent.  The 
Council  in  "TruUo"  (a.d.  692)  forbade 
any  festival  to  be  observed  in  Lent,  except 
the  Sabbath,  the  Lord's  Day,  and  the  An- 
nunciation, and  restored  this  festival  to  its 
original  place.  The  Church  of  England 
has  always  observed  it  on  March  25,  the 
collect,  epistle,  and  gospel  being  the  same  in. 
the  modern  English  as  in  the  Sarum  Use. 
In  the  calendar  the  day  is  called  the  "  An- 
nunciation of  our  Lady,"  and  hence  the 
25th  of  March  is  called  Lady-day.  It  is 
observed  as  a  "scarlet  day"  at  the  Uni- 
versities of  Cambridge  and  Oxford.  [H.] 
.  ANOINTING.  In  the  Jewish  Church, 
the  ceremonial  anointing  of  persons  and 
things  was  very  frequent,  and  in  many 
cases  was  appointed  by  Divine  authority 
(Ex.  xxviii.  41;  xxix.  7;  xxx.  20-29;  1 
Sam.  X.  1 ;  XV.  1 ;  2  Kings  ix.  1-3,  &o.  &c.). 
It  was  adopted  into  the  Christian  Church 
from  the  first,  and  St.  James  speaks  of  it  as 
a  regular  custom  with  regard  to  the  sick 
(v.  14).  'It  was  also  generally  used  at  Baptism, 
Confirmation,  Ordination,  and  afterwards  at 
Coronations,  in  which  latter    ceremony  it 


ANOMCEANS 

still  has  a  place.  In  the  office  for  the  sick 
ia  the  prayer-book  of  1549  there  was  this 
direction,  "  If  the  sick  person  desire  to  be 
anointed,  then  shall  the  Priest  anoint  him  on 
the  forehead  or  breast  only,  making  the  sign 
of  the  cross,  saying  thus :  As  with  this  visible 
oil,  thy  body  outwardly  is  anointed :  so  oui 
heavenly  Father,  Almighty  God,  grant  of 
His  infinite  goodness,  that  thy  soul  inwardly 
may  be  anointed  with  the  Holy  Ghost,"  &c. 

The  Church  of  Eome  has  converted  this 
"  godly  custom  "  into  a  sacrament  necessary 
to  salvation  (Council  of  Trent,  Canons  I.- 
IV.),  which  in  early  times  it  never  was 
considered  to  be.  In  the  Church  of  England 
anointing  is  at  the  present  time  never  used, 
except  at  the  Coronation  of  the  Sovereign. 
(See  ExtreTne  Unction.) 

ANOMCEANS.  (From  iLv6iiows,  un- 
like.) The  name  of  the  extreme  Arians 
in  the  fourth  century,  because  they  held 
the  essence  of  the  Son  of  God  to  be  unlike 
that  of  the  Father.  They  [were  sometimes 
called  Aetians  after  Aetius,  their  first  leader, 
or  Eunomians  after  Eunomius  his  secretary. 
Their  chief  opponents  were  Gregory  Nyssen. 
and  St.  John  Chrysostom.  They  were  con- 
demned by  the  semi- Arians,  at  the  Council 
of  Seleucia,  a.d.  359,  and  more  decisively 
at  the  Council  of  Constantinople  a.d.  381. 

ANTELUCAN.  In  times  of  persecu- 
tion, the  Christians  being  unable  to  meet 
for  divine  worship  in  the  open  day,  held 
their  assemblies  in  the  night.  The  like 
assemblies  were  afterwards  continued  from 
feelings  of  piety  and  devotion,  and  called 
Antelucan,  or  asseiribUes  before  daylight. 

ANTHEM.  A  hymn,  sung  in  parts 
alternately.  Such,  at  least,  would  appear  to 
be  its  original  sense.  The  word  is  derived 
from  the  Greek  ' AvTicjioiva,  (not  avdvjxvos, 
as  Dr.  Johnson  gives  it),  which  signifies,  as 
Isidorus  interprets  it,  "  Vox  redproca,"  &c., 
one  voice  succeeding  another ;  that  is,  two 
choruses  singing  ty  turns.  (See  Antiphon.) 
In  the  Greek  Church  it  was  more  particu- 
larly applied  to  one  of  the  Alleluia  Psalms 
sung  after  those  of  the  day.  In  the  Roman 
and  unreformed  Western  ofSces  it  is  ordina- 
rily applied  to  a  short  sentence  sung  before 
and  after  one  of  the  Psalms  of  the  day ;  so 
called,  according  to  Cardinal  Bona,  because 
it  gives  the  tone  to  the  Psalms  which  are 
sung  antiphonally,  or  by  each  side  of  the 
choir  alternately ;  and  then  at  the  end  both 
choirs  join  in  the  anthem.  The  same 
term  is  given  to  short  sentences  said  or 
sung  at  different  parts  of  the  service; 
also  occasionally  to  metrical  hymns.  The 
real  reason  of  the  application  of  the  term 
in  these  instances  seems  to  be  this,  that 
these  sentences  are  a  sort  of  response  to, 
or  alternation  with,  the  other  parts  of  the 
office.     The  preacher's  text  was  at  the  be- 


ANTHOLOGIUM 


39 


ginnmg  of  the  Eeformation  sometimes 
called  the  Anthem.  (Strype,  Ann.  of  the 
Ref.  chap.  ix.  a.d.  1559.)  In  this  sense 
it  is  applied  in  King  Edward's  First  Book 
to  the  Sentences  in  the  Visitation  of  the 
Sick,  "Eemember  not,"  &c.,  &c.,  "O 
Saviour  of  the  world,"  &c.,  which  were  ob- 
viously never  intended  to  be  sung.  In 
the  same  book  it  is  applied  to  the  hjmms 
peculiar  to  Easter-day,  and  to  the  prayer 
in  the  Communion  Service,  "Turn  thou 
us,"  &o.,  both  of  which  are  prescribed  to 
be  said  or  sung.  In  our  present  Prayer 
Book  it  occurs  only  in  reference  to  the 
Easter  Hymn,  and  in  the  rubrics  after  the 
third  Collects  of  Morning  and  Evening 
Prayer.  These  rubrics  were  first  inserted 
at  the  last  Review,  though  there  Is  no 
doubt  that  the  anthem  had  always  been 
customarily  performed  in  the  same  place. 
To  the  anthem  so  performed  Milton  alluded 
in  the  well-known  words,  "  In  service  high 
and  anthems  clear  ; "  these  expressions,  as 
well  as  the  whole  phraseology  of  that  un- 
rivalled passage,  being  technically  correct : 
the  service  meaning  the  Church  Hymns, 
set  to  varied  harmonies ;  the  anthems  (of 
which  two  were  commonly  performed  in 
the  fall  Sunday  morning  service),  the  com- 
positions now  in  question. 

The  English  Anthem,  as  the  term  has 
long  been  practically  understood,  sanc- 
tioned by  the  universal  use  of  the  Chui-ch 
of  England,  has  no  exact  equivalent  in  the 
service  of  other  Churches.  It  resembles, 
but  not  exactly,  the  Motets  of  foreign 
choirs,  and  occasionally  their  Responsories 
or  Antiphons.  There  are  a  few  metrical 
anthems,  corresponding  to  the  hymns  of 
those  choirs.  But,  generally  speaking,  the 
English  anthem  is  set  to  words  from  Holy 
Scriptrffe,  or  the  Liturgy ;  sung,  not  to  a 
chant,  or  an  air,  like  that  of  a  hymn,  but 
to  varied  consecutive  strains,  admitting  of 
every  diversity  of  solo,  verse,  and  chorus. 
(See  Jebb,  Choral  Service,  p.  377,  &c.) 
"The  Easter-day  Anthem,  at  the  time  of 
the  last  Review,  was  not  usually  sung,  as 
now,  to  a  chant,  but  to  varied  harmonies, 
(as  is  still  the  case  at  Salisbury  cathedral,) 
— and  in  the  Sealed  Book  it  is  to  be  ob- 
served, that  it  is  not  printed  like  the 
Psalms,  in  verses,  but  in  paragraphs. 
Properly  speaking,  our  services,  technically 
so  called,  (see  Service,)  are  anthems. 

An  anthem  in  choirs  and  places  where 
they  '  sing  is  appointed  by  the  rubric  in 
the  daily  service  in  the  P;  ay er  Book,  after 
the  third  Collect,  both  at  Morning  and 
Evening  Prayer.    [H.] 

ANTHOLOGIUM.  Book  of  Flowers. 
(In  Latin,  Flnrilegium.)  The  title  of  a 
book  in  the  Greek  Church,  divided  into 
twelve  months,  containing  the  offices  sung' 


40 


ANTHROPOLATK^ 


throughout  the  whole  year,  on  the  festivals 
of  our  Saviour,  the  Virgin  Mary,  and  other 
remarkable  saints.  It  is  observable  from 
this  book  that  the  Greek  Church  celebrates 
Easter  at  the  same  time  with  the  Church  of 
England,  notwithstonding  that  they  differ 
from  us  in  the  lunar  cycle.— Broughton, 
Bihliotheca,  who  quotes  Cave's  Hist. 
Lit.  v.. 

ANTHROPOLATBiE.  {Man  -  wor- 
shippers.) A  name  of  abuse  given  to 
churchmen  by  the  Apollinarians,  because 
the  former  maintained  that  Christ,  whom 
both  admitted  to  be  the  object  of  the 
Christian's  worship,  was  a  perfect  man,  of  a 
reasonable  soul  and  human  flesh  subsisting. 
This  the  Apollinarians  denied.  It  was 
always  the  way  with  heretics  to  apply  to 
churchmen  terms  of  reproach,  while  they 
assumed  to  themselves  distinctive  appella- 
tions of  honour:  thus  the  Maniohees,  for 
instance,  while  they  called  themselves  the 
elect,  the  Messed,  and  the  pure,  gave  to  the 
churchmen  the  name  of  simple  ones.  It  is 
not  less  a  sign  of  a  sectarian  spirit  to  assume 
a  distinctive  name  of  honour,  than  to  im- 
pose on  the  Church  a  name  of  reproach, 
for  both  tend  to  divided  communion  in 
spirit  or  in  fact.  There  is  this  good,  how- 
ever, to  be  gathered  from  these  slanderous 
and  vain-glorious  arts  of  heretics;  that 
their  terms  of  reproach  serve  to  indicate 
some  true  doctrine  of  the  Church:  as,  for 
instance,  that  of  Anthropolatrss  determines 
the  opiaion  of  Catholics  touching  Christ's 
human  nature;  while  the  names  of  dis- 
tinction which  heretics  themselves  assume, 
usually  serve  to  throw  light  on  the  history 
of  their  own  error. 

ANTHROPOMORPHITES.  Heretics 
who  were  so  called  because  they  maintained 
that  God  had  a  human  shape,  and  held  that 
such  expressions  as  those  in  Gen.  vi.  8,  viii. 
21 ;  Psa.  xxxiv.  15  ;  Num.  xi.  18 ;  Is.  v.,  ix. 
&c.,  were  to  be  understood  literally,  not 
metaphorically.  Tertullian  has  been  sup- 
posed to  hold  this  idea  from  his  words, "  Quis 
enim  negabit  Deum  corpus  esse,  etsi  Deus 
Spiritus  est,"  &c.  {Adv.  Prax.  cvii.),  but  in 
fact  he  only  asserts  that  God  is  not  a  mere 
phantom,  but  has  a  substantial  existence. 
Audseus  or  Audius  (a.d.  340),  a  monk  of 
Syria,  founded  a  sect  of  this  name  (also 
called  Audseans  or  Audians) ;  and  at  the 
end  of  the  century  the  ignorant  monks  of 
Nitria  (Egypt)  held  very  gross  ideas  with 
regard  to  the  person  of  God,  as  related  by 
Socrates  (K  E.  vi.  7-17)  and  Sozomen  (viii. 
1-19).  Eatherius,  bishop  of  Verona  in  the 
tenth  century  (a.d.  939),  had  a  controversy 
with  Anthropomorphites ;  but  these  poor 
people  are  not  to  be  classed  among  heretics, 
they  were  simply  ignorant,  and  formed  their 
ideas  from  the  pictures,  &c.,  they  saw  in 


ANTINOMIANS 

churches. — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  316, 
339,  378,  612. 

ANTICHRIST.  The  man  of  sin,  who 
is  to  precede  the  second  advent  of  our 
blessed  Saviour  Jesus  Christ. 

I.  Two  texts  in  Daniel  (vii.  8,  viii.  4-8) 
and  one  in  St.  Paul's  Epistles  (2  Thess.  ii. 
3-8)  have  always  been  considered  as  referring 
to  Antichrist.  (See  Pusey  on  Dan.)  And  al- 
though there  are  no  other  passages  in  the 
New  Testament  which  speak  of  Antichrist 
as  a  person,  yet  St.  John  several  times 
mentions  the  spirit  of  Antichrist,  and  in 
one  passage  writes  of  the  matter  as  one 
with  which  his  readers  must  be  conversant. 
"  This  is  that  spirit  of  Antichrist,"  he  says, 
"  of  which  ye  have  heard."  (1  St.  John  iv. 
3).  With  the  passages  in  Daniel  and 
St.  Paul  may  be  compared  the  mystical 
account  of  the  dragon  in  Rev.  xiii.  4-18. 

II.  Early  writers  seem  to  agree  in  two 
points,  namely,  that  Antichrist  will  appear 
in  the  age  immediately  preceding  the  second 
coming  of  Christ,  and  that  he  will  be  a 
person  especially  under  the  influence  of 
Satan,  if  not  Satan  himself  in  human  form. 
In  later  times  many  writers  have  asserted 
that  the  Pope  of  Rome  is  Antichrist,  while 
others  imagine  that  the  spirit  of  infidelity 
will  prove  to  be  the  destructive  dragon. 
But  it  would  be  impossible  to  give  all  the 
ideas  that  have  been  promulgated  on  this 
most  mystical  subject.  It  is  dealt  with  to 
some  extent  in  every  commentary  on  Daniel 
and  the  Apocalypse. 

ANTIDORON.  A  name  given  by  the 
Greeks  to  that  portion  of  the  bread  which 
at  Holy  Communion  has  been  offered,  but 
not  consecrated.  It  is  distributed  to  non- 
communicants,  and  would  seem  to  be  a 
relic  of  the  agape. — ^Neale's  Introd.  Hist,  of 
E.  Church,  525.    - 

ANTILEGOMENA.  Things  spoken 
against.  An  ecclesiastical  term  for  dis- 
puted books,  claiming  to  be  portions  of  Holy 
Scripture.  Eusebius,  H.  E.  iii.  24,  25, 
makes  three  principal  divisions  of  all 
writings  which  laid  claim  to  apostolical  au- 
thority :  (i.)  the  acknowledged  to.  ofuikoynv- 
[leva ;  (ii.)  the  disputed  ra  di/riXeyo'fiej'a ;  (iii.) 
the  heretical ;  and  he  subdivided  the  second 
class  into  two :  (a)  "  the  generally  known," 
consisting  of  the  Epistles  of  St.  James  and 
St.  Jude,  i.  St.  Peter,  ii.  &  iii.  St.  John. 
O)  "  the  spurious,"  consisting  of  the  Acts  of 
Paul,  the  Shepherd  of  Hermas,  the  Revela- 
tion of  Peter,  the  Epistle  of  Barnabas,  and 
the  "  Teaching  of  the  Apostles."  This  last 
work  has  been  lately  discovered  by  Bryermios, 
archbishop  of  Nicomedia. 

ANTINOMIANS.  {mirl,  vSfws).  Those 
who  hold  that  the  moral  law,  the  law  of 
God,  is  not  binding  upon  believers  under 
the  Gospel. 


ANTINOMIANS 

In  the  earliest  times  error  upoa  this  point 
seems  to  have  been  derived  partly  from  the 
Gnostic  theory  (see  Iren.  Adv.  Exr.  i.-vi. 
2, 3)  that  some  men  were  incapable  of  salva- 
tion, while  others,  being  of  divine  origin, 
however  licentious  their  lives,  must  be  saved, 
j)artly  from  a  perversion  of  St.  Paul's  teach- 
ing respecting  liberty  from  the  law  of  Moses. 
Allusion  is  probably  made  to  this  by  St. 
Paul  (Col.  ii.  18, 19  ;  1  Tim.  iv.  1-5,  vi.  20, 
21),  and  by  St.  John  (1  St.  John  u.  18,  iii. 
7).  St.  James  when  he  wrote  his  epistle  had 
evidently  the  object  of  contradicting  certain 
ideas  which  had  been  erroneously  based  on 
some  of  St.  Paul's  teaching,  in  this  respect. 
(Bishop  BuU  on  Imt.  ii.  c.  4).  Cerinthus, 
who  was  contemporary  with  St.  John, 
promulgated  these  Antinomian  fallacies 
(Eusebius,  Eac.  Hist.  iii.  c.  38) ;  and  the 
followers  of  Simon  Magus,  of  whom  it  was 
said,  "ex  quo  universje  hasreses  substi- 
tuerunt,"  were  guilty  of  the  grossest  im- 
moralities under  the  covering  of  "faith 
tmto  salvation."     (Irenjeus,  lib.  i.  c.  24.) 

n.  Of  the  more  modern  Antinomian 
heresy  the  founder  was  John  Agricola,  a 
Saxon  divine,  a  contemporary,  a  country- 
man, and  at  first  a  disciple,  of  Luther.  He 
was  of  a  restless  temper,  and  wrote  against 
Melanchthon ;  and  having  obtained  a  pro- 
fessorship at  Wittemberg,  he  first  taught 
Antinomianism  there,  about  the  year  1535. 
The  Papists,  in  their  disputes  with  the 
Protestants  of  that  day,  carried  the  merit 
of  good  works  to  an  extravagant  length; 
and  this  induced  some  of  their  opponents, 
as  is  too  often  the  case,  to  run  into  the 
opposite  extreme.  The  doctrine  of  Agri- 
cola  was  in  itself  obscure,  and  perhaps 
represented  worse  than  it  really  was  by 
Luther,  who  wrote  with  acrimony  against 
him,  and  first  styled  him  and  his  followers 
Antinomians  —  perhaps  thereby  "  intend- 
ing," as  Dr.  Hey  conjectures,  "  to  disgrace 
the  notions  of  Agricola,  and  make  even 
him  ashamed  of  them."  Agricola  stood 
on  his  own  defence,  and  complained  that 
opinions  were  imputed  to  him  which  he 
did  not  hold. 

About  the  same  time,  Nicholas  Amsdorf, 
bishop  of  Naumburg  in  Saxony,  fell  under 
the  same  odious  name  and  imputation, 
and  seems  to  have  been  treated  more  un- 
fairly than  even  Agricola  himseK.  The 
bishop  died  at  Magdeburg  in  1541,  and 
some  say  that  his  followers  were  called  for 
a  time  Amsdorfians,  after  his  name.  The 
Anabaptists  of  Minister  were  Antinomians 
of  the  grossest  kind  (see  Anahaptists),  and 
Antinomian  principles  were  common  among 
the  Independents  in  England,  during  the 
Protectorate  of  Oliver  Cromwell,  who  was 
himself  an  Antinomian  of  the  worst  sort. 

According  to  them,  it  was  one  of  the 


ANTI-P.^D0BAPT1STS 


41 


essential  and  distinctive  characters  of  the 
elect,  that  they  could  not  do  anything 
displeasing  to  God,  or  prohibited  by  the 
law.  "  Let  me  speak  freely  to  you,  and  teU 
you,"  says  Dr.  Tobias  Crisp,  (who  may  be 
styled  the  primipilus  of  the  more  modern 
scheme  of  Antinomianism,  and  whose  doc- 
trines were  vigorously  opposed  by  Tillot- 
son,  Baxter,  and  especially  Williams, 
author  of  'Gospel  Truth  Stated  and 
Vindicated '),  "  that  the  Lord  hath  no  more 
to  lay  to  the  charge  of  an  elect  person,  yet 
in  the  height  of  his  iniquity,  and  in  the 
excess  of  riot,  and  committing  all  the 
abominations  that  can  be  committed;  I 
say,  even  then,  when  an  elect  person  runs 
such  a  course,  the  Lord  hath  no  more  to  lay 
to  that  person's  charge,  than  God  hath  to 
lay  to  the  charge  of  a  believer :  nay,  God 
hath  no  more  to  lay  to  the  charge  of  such  a 
person  than  He  hath  to  lay  to  the  charge  of 
a  saint  triumphant  in  glory.  The  elect  of 
God,  they  are  the  heirs  of  God ;  and  as 
they  are  heirs,  so  the  first  being  of  them 
puts  them  into  the  right  of  inheritance,  and 
there  is  no  time  but  such  a  person  is  the 
child  of  God." 

While  the  Socinian  Unitarians  place  the 
whole  of  their  religion  in  morality,  in  dis- 
regard of  Christian  faith,  the  Antinomians 
rely  so  on  faith  as  to  undervalue  morality. 
Their  doctrines  at  least  have  too  much  that 
appearance. 

In  short,  according  to  Dr.  Williams, 
Dr.  Crisp's  scheme  is  briefly  this:  "That 
by  God's  mere  electing  decree  all  saving 
blessings  are  by  Divine  obligation  made 
ours,  and  nothing  more  is  needful  to  our 
title  to  these  blessings :  that  on  the  cross 
all  the  sins  of  the  elect  were  transferred  to 
Christ,  and  ceased  ever  after  to  be  their 
sins :  that  at  the  first  moment  of  concep- 
tion a  title  to  all  those  decreed  blessings  is 
personally  applied  to  the  elect,  and  they 
are  invested  actually  therein.  Hence  the 
elect  have  nothing  to  do,  in  order  to  an  in- 
terest in  any  of  those  blessings,  nor  ought 
they  to  intend  the  least  good  to  themselves 
in  what  they  do :  sin  can  do  them  no  harm 
because  it  is  none  of  theirs;  nor  can  God 
afiiict  them  for  any  sin."  And  all  the  rest 
of  his  opinions  "  follow  in  a  chain,"  adds 
Dr.  W.,  "to  the  dethroning  of  Christ, 
enervating  his  laws  and  pleadings,  obstruct- 
ing the  great  design  of  redemption,  op- 
posing the  very  scope  of  the  gospel,  and  the 
ministry  of  Christ  and  his  prophets  and 
apostles." — Adams,  Diet,  of  all  Religions, 
art.  Antinomians ;  Bogue  &  Beimet's  Hist, 
of  Dissenters,  vol.  i.  p.  399. 

ANTI-PiEDOBAPTISTS.  (Prom  a^rl, 
against,  nah,  child,  pdirTwiia,  baptism.) 
Persons  who  are  opposed  to  the  baptism 
of  infants.     In  this  country,  this  sect  ar- 


42 


ANTIOOH 


rogate  to  themselves  the  title  'of  Baptists 
par  excellence,  as  though  no  other  body  of 
Christians  baptized :  just  as  the  Socinians 
extenuate  their  heresy  by  calling  them- 
selves Unitarians  ;  thereby  insinuating  that 
those  who  hold  the  mystery  of  the  Holy 
'i'ruiity  do  not  believe  in  one  God.  (See 
Anabaptists;  Baptism.') 

ANTIOOH,  PATEIAROH  OP.  The 
chief  bishop  of  one  of  the  four  provinces 
into  which  the  Eastern  Church  is  still 
nominally  divided,  the  other  three  being 
Constantinople  (which  ranks  first),  Alexan- 
dria, and  Jerusalem.  There  are  three 
prelates  who  claim  this  title  and  rank  (1) 
the  head  of  the  Greeks,  Melchites,  or  Syrian 
Christians,  (2)  of  the  Syrian  Monophysites, 
(3)  of  the  Maronites.  To  these  may  be 
added  a  fourth  with  the  same  title,  created 
by  the  Pope  of  Eome  "in  partibus  in- 
fidelium."  The  orthodox  patriarch  resides 
at  Damascus,  and  has  sixteen  bishops  under 
him.  (See  Colon.  Church  Ghron.  1860, 
p.  231.) 

ANTIPHON.  la  its  earliest  form  this 
seems  to  have  been  a  single  verse  out  of  any 
psalm,  repeated  after  or  even  before  the 
recitation  of  the  psalm,  with  a  view  of 
bringing  into  prominence,  and  fastening 
attention  upon,  some  special  idea  connected 
with  it.  Afterwards  antiphons  came  to  be 
selected,  not  exclusively  from  the  particular 
psalms  to  which  they  were  affixed,  but  from 
appropriate  passages  of  Scripture  which 
might  be  similarly  applied.  (Blunt,  P.  B. 
Ixii.).  The  antiphon,  "  0  Saviour  of  the 
world,"  in  the  ofBoe  of  the  Visitation  of  the 
Sick,  is  the  only  one  left  of  the  many  anti- 
phons with  which  our  services  were  formerly 
studded.  It  emphasises  the  leading  idea  of 
the  previous  psalm,  and  converts  it  into  a 
Christian  prayer. — P.  B.,  its  History,  &c., 
Evan  DanieL     (See  Anthem.}    [H.] 

ANTIPHONY,  or  antiphonal  singing. 
The  chant  or  alternate  singing  of  a  Chris- 
tian choir.  This  is  the  most  ancient  form 
of  church  music.  Diodorus  and  ^Flavian, 
the  leaders  of  the  orthodox  party  at  Antioch 
during  the  ascendency  of  Arianism,  in  the 
fourth  century,  and  St.  Ambrose  at  Milan, 
instead  of  leaving  the  chanting  to  the 
choristers,  as  had  been  usual,  divided  the 
whole  congregation  into  two  choii's,  which 
sang  the  psalms  alternately.  The  custom 
is  said,  by  Socrates  the  historian,  to  have 
been  first  introduced  among  the  Greeks  by 
Ignatius.  St.  Basil  tells  us  that,  in  his 
time,  about  a.d.  370,  the  Christians,  "  rising 
from  their  prayers,  proceeded  to  singing  of 
psalms,  dividing  themselves  into  two  parts, 
and  singing  by  turns."  TertuUian  remarks, 
that  "  when  one  side  of  the  choir  sing  to  the 
other,  they  both  provoke  it  by  a  holy 
contention,   and    relieve    it  by  a    mutual 


ANTI-POPE 

supply  and  change."  In  the  cathedral 
worship  of  the  Church  Universal,  the 
psalms  of  the  day  are  chanted  throughout. 
And  in  order  to  preserve  their  responsive 
character,  two  full  choirs  are  stationed  one 
on  each  side  of  the  church.  One  of  these 
having  chanted  one  or  two  verses  (the 
usual  compass  of  the  chant-tune)  remains 
silent,  while  the  opposite  choir  replies  in 
the  verses  succeeding;  and  at  the  end  of 
each  psakn  (and  of  each  division  of  the 
119th  Psalm)  the  Gloria  Patri  is  sung  by 
the  united  choirs  in  chorus,  accompanied 
by  the  peal  of  the  great  organ. 

The  reading  of  the  psalms  by  parson  and 
clerk,  in  alternate  verses,  and  the  usage  now 
prevalent  in  foreign  churches  subject  to 
Rome,  of  chanting  one  verse  by  a  single 
voice,  and  the  other  by  the  full  choir,  is  not 
ancient,  and  is  admitted  to  be  incorrect  by 
some  continental  ritualists  themselves.  This 
method  is  quite  destructive  of  the  genuine 
effect  of  antiphonal  chanting,  which  ought 
to  be  equally  balanced  on  each  side  of  the 
choir.  It  may  indeed  be  accepted  as  a, 
sort  of  modification  of  the  ordinary  paro- 
chial mode ;  but  in  regular  choirs  it  would 
be  a  clear  innovation,  a  retrograde  move- 
ment, instead  of  an  improvement. — Jebb, 
Choral  Service,  pp.  277  et  seq. 

ANTIPHONAR.  The  book  which  con- 
tains the  invitatories,  responsories,  verses, 
collects,  and  whatever  else  is  sung  in  the 
choir ;  but  not  including  the  hymns  pe- 
culiar to  the  Communion  Service,  which 
are  contained  in  the  Gradual,  or  Grail. 

ANTI-POPE.  He  that  usurps  the  pope- 
dom in  opposition  to  the  right  pope.  Geddes 
gives  the  history  of  no  less  than  twenty- 
four  schisms  in  the  Koman  Church  caused 
by  anti-popes,  though  according  to  Gautier 
and  Bergier  (^Dict.  de  Theologie,  i.  135, 
Paris,  1863)  there  were  more.  Some  took 
their  rise  from  a  diversity  of  doctrines  or 
belief,  which  led  different  parties  to  elect 
each  their  several  pope ;  but  they  generally 
took  their  rise  from  dubious  controverted 
rights  of  election.  During  the  great  schism, 
which,  commencing  towards  the  close  of  the 
fourteenth  century,  lasted  for  over  sixty  years, 
there  was  always  a  pope  and  anti-pope; 
and  as  to  the  fact  which  of  the  two  rivals 
was  pope,  and  which  anti-pope,  it  is  im- 
possible even  now  to  decide.  The  greatest 
powers  of  Europe  were  at  this  time  divided 
in  their  opinions  on  the  subject.  As  is 
observed  by  some  Roman  Catholic  writers,' 
many  pious  and  gifted  persons,  who  are 
now  numbered  among  the  saints  of  the 
Church,  were  to  be  found  indifferently  in 
either  obedience ;  which  sufficiently  proved, 
as  they  assert,  that  the  eternal  salvation  of 
the  faithful  was  not  in  this  case  endangered 
■  by  their  error.      The  schism  began  soon 


ANTI-TYPE 

after  the  election  of  Urban  VI.,  and  was 
terminated  by  the  Council  of  Constance. 
By  that  Council  three  rival  popes  were 
deposed,  and  the  peace  of  the  Church  was 
restored  by  the  election  of  Martin  V. — 
M.  Geddes,  Preb.  of  Sarum,  Miacell.  Tracts, 
vol.  iii..  Tract  4,  London,  1706.  See  also 
Gibbon,  especially  viii.  351,  ed.  Smith,  1854. 
ANTI-TYPE.  A  Greek  word,  properly 
signifying  a  type  or  figure  corresponding  to 
some  other  type :  the  word  is  commonly 
used  in  theological  writings  to  denote  the 
person  in  whom  any  prophetic  type  is  ful- 
filled :  thus,  our  Blessed  Saviour  is  called 
the  Anti-type  of  the  Paschal  lamb  under  the 
Jewish  law. 

APHOEISMUS.  (Prom  d^opiV/ioy,  sepa- 
ration. A  term  used  in  the  primitive  Church 
for  the  lesser  form  of  excommunication. 
Those  under  this  ban  were  excluded  from 
participation  in  the  Holy  Eucharist,  but 
were  allowed  to  be  present  at  those  portions 
of  the  service  at  which  catechumens  could 
attend.  With  regard  to  the  clergy  it 
implied  suspension,  but  did  not  involve 
excommunication. 

APOCALYPSE.  A  revelation.  The 
name  sometimes  given  to  the  last  book  of 
the  New  Testament,  the  Eevelation  of  St. 
John  the  Divine,  from  its  Greek  title, 
mvoKoKvi^is,  which  has  the  same  meaning. 

This  is  a  canonical  book  of  the  New 
Testament.  It  was  written,  according  to 
Irenasus,  about  the  year  of  Christ  96,  in 
the  island  of  Patmos,  whither  St.  John  had 
been  banished  by  the  emperor  Domitian. 
The  Eevelation  has  not  at  all  times  been 
esteemed  canonical.  There  were  many 
Churches  of  Greece,  as  St.  Jerome  informs 
us,  which  did  not  receive  it ;  neither  is  it  in 
the  catalogue  of  the  canonical  books  pre- 
pared by  the  Council  of  Laodicea;  nor  in 
that  of  St.  Cyril  of  Jerusalem ;  but  Justin, 
Irenseus,  Origen,  Cyprian,  Clemens  of 
Alexandria,  Tertullian,  and  all  the  fathers 
of  the  fourth,  fifth,  and  following  centuries, 
quote  the  Eevelations  as  a  book  then  ac- 
knowledged to  be  canonical. 

APOCRYPHA.  (See  Bible,  Scriptures.) 
From  ano  and  Kprnra,  to  hide,  "  because 
they  were  wont  to  be  read  not  openly  and 
in  common,  but  as  it  were  in  secret  and 
apart."  Certain  books  appended  to  the 
sacred  writings.  {Bible  of  1539,  Preface 
to  Apocrypha.)  There  is  no  authority, 
internal  or  external,  for  admitting  these 
books  into  the  sacred  canon.  They  were 
not  received  as  portions  of  the  Old  Testa- 
ment by  the  Jews,  to  whom  "  were  com- 
mitted the  oracles  of  God ; "  they  are  not 
cited  and  alluded  to  in  any  part  of  the 
New  Testament ;  and  they  are  expressly 
rejected  by  St.  Athanasius  and  St.  Jerome 
in  the  fourth  century,  though  these  two 


APOLLINAKIANS 


43. 


fathers  speak  of  them  with  respect.  There 
is,  therefore,  no  ground  for  applying  the 
books  of  the  Apocrypha  "  to  establish  any 
doctrine,"  but  they  are  highly  valuable  as 
ancient  writings,  which  throw  considerable 
light  upon  the  phraseology  of  Scripture, 
and  upon  the  history  and  manners  of  the 
East ;  and  as  they  contain  many  noble 
sentiments  and  useful  precepts,  the  Church 
of  England  doth  read  them  for  "  example 
of  life  and  instruction  of  manners."  (Art. 
VI.)  They  are  frequently  quoted  with 
great  respect  in  the  Homilies,  although 
persons  who  bestow  much  praise  upon  the 
Homilies  are  wont  to  follow  a  very  contrary 
course.  The  Church  of  Eome,  at  the  fourth 
session  of  the  Council  of  Trent,  admitted 
them  to  he  of  equal  authority  with  Scrip- 
ture. Thereby  the  modern  Church  of  Eome 
differs  from  the  Catholic  Church ;  and  by 
altering  the  canon  of  Scripture,  and  at  the 
same  time  making  her  dictum  the  rule  of 
communion,  renders  it  impossible  for  those 
Churches  which  defer  to  antiquity  to  hold 
communion  with  her.  Divines  differ  in 
opinion  as  to  the  degree  of  respect  due  to 
those  ancient  vvrritings.  The  reading  of  the 
Apocryphal  books  in  churches  formed  one 
of  the  grievances  of  the  Puritans:  om- 
Eeformers,  however,  made  a  selection  for 
certain  holy  days ;  and  for  the  first  lesson 
from  the  evening  of  the  27th  of  September, 
till  the  morning  of  the  23rd  of  November, 
inclusive.  But  this  by  the  new  Lectionary 
has  been  changed,  and  though  passages  in 
Ecolesiasticus,  Wisdom,  and  Baruch  are- 
appointed  to  be  read  between  October  27 
and  Nov.  18,  and  on  certain  Saints'  days, 
the  Apocryphal  stories  of  Susanna  and  Bel 
and  the  dragon,  and  other  parts,  have  been 
eliminated. 

APOLLINAKIANS.  FoUowers  of  Apol- 
linaris  or  ApoUinarius,  about  the  middle  of 
the  fourth  century.  In  his  early  life 
ApoUinaris  was  a  friend  of  St.  Athanasius, 
and  about  a.d.  362  was  consecrated  to  th& 
see  of  Laodicea,  which,  notwithstanding  his 
heretical  opinions,  he  held  till  his  death  in 
392.  He  denied  that  our  Saviour  had  a 
reasonable  human  soul  (yous),  and  asserted 
that  the  Logos  or  Divine  nature  supplied 
the  place  of  it.  As  Arius  denied  that 
Christ  was  perfect  God,  so  ApoUinaris,  not 
perhaps  intentionally,  but  in  effect,  denied 
that  He  was  perfect  man.  This  is  one  of 
the  sects  we  anathematize  when  we  read 
the  Athanasian  Creed.  The  doctrine  of 
ApoUiuaris  was  condemned  by  several  pro- 
vincial councils,  and  at  length  by  the 
General  Council  of  Constantinople,  in  381. 
In  short,  it  was  attacked  at  the  same  time- 
by  the  laws  of  the  emperors,  the  decrees  of 
councils,  and  the  writings  of  the  learned, 
and  sank,  by  degrees,  under   their  united 


41 


APOLOGY 


force.— Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  254, 
308 ;  Blunt's  Diet,  of  Sects. 

APOLOGy  (an-o,  Xdyor),  ia  its  primaiy 
sense,  and  always  in  tlieology,  means  a 
■defence  from  attack;  an  answer  to  objec- 
tions. Tbus  the  Greek  word  avokoyia, 
from  wbich.  it  comes,  is,  in  Acts  xxii.  1, 
translated  by  defence ;  in  xxv.  16,  by  answer; 
and  in  2  Cor.  vii.  11,  by  "  clearing  of  your- 
selves." The  speech  of  the  first  martyr,  Sc. 
Stephen,  in  answer  to  his  accusers,  is  com- 
monly called  his  "  apology."  There  were 
several  Apologies  for  Christianity  in  early 
times,  the  chief  of  which  were  as  follows  : 
(1)  That  of  Quadratus,  presented  to  Hadrian 
in  A.D.  123  or  131,  (Euseb.  iv.  3,)  in  which 
appeal  is  made  for  witness,  to  the  many 
persons  healed  by  our  Lord ;  (2)  of  Aris- 
.tides,  presented  about  the  same  time ;  (3) 
two  of  Justin  Martyr,  the  one  addressed  to 
Antoninus  Pius,  a.d.  138,  the  other  to 
JMarcus  Aurelius ;  and  also  those  of  Athena- 
goras  and  Tatian,  all  of  which  are  extant ; 
^4)  of  Melito,  bishop  of  Sardis :  and  (5) 
Apoliinaris,  bishop  of  Hierapolis,  both  pre- 
sented to  Marcus  Aurelius ;  (6)  of  Mil- 
■tiades;  (7)  of  TheophUus,  bishop  of  Antioch, 
presented  to  Antylocus,  a.d.  160 ;  (8)  of 
Tertullian,  a.d.  194  written  first  in  Latin, 
and  afterwards  translated  into  Greek;  (9) 
of  Arnobius  of  Sicca  in  Africa,  a.d.  303. 
The  object  of  the  Apologists,  besides  proving 
the  reasonableness  of  their  faith  and  religion 
and  the  errors  of  heathenism,  was  to  break 
the  force  of  those  falsehoods  and  contume- 
lies by  which  they  were  unjustly  assailed — 
atheists,  magicians,  self-murderers,  haters 
of  the  light,  being  amongst  the  ignominious 
epithets  employed  against  them  by  Tacitus, 
■-Suetonius,  Celsus,  &c. — Eusebius,  iv.  3,  seq. ; 
Bingham,  Ant.  i.  c.ii.  p.  5  ;  Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  i.  137,  162,  168,  169,  &c. 

APOSTASY.  (dTTooTaa-cs,  faUing  away.) 
A  forsaking  or  renouncing  of  our  religion, 
either  formally,  by  an  open  declaration  in 
words,  or  virtually,  by  our  actions.  The 
word  has  several  degrees  of  signification. 
The  primitive  Christian  Church  distin- 
guished several  kinds  of  apostasy  >  the 
first,  of  those  who  went  entirely  from  Chris- 
tianity to  Judaism.  The  second,  of  those 
who  mingled  Judaism  and  Christianity  to- 
gether. The  third,  of  those  who  complied 
so  far  with  the  Jews  as  to  communicate 
with  them  in  many  of  their  unlawful  prac- 
tices, without  formally  professing  their  re- 
ligion ;  and  the  fourth,  of  those  who,  after 
having  been  some  time  Christians,  volun- 
tarily relapsed  into  Paganism.  It  is  ex- 
pressly revealed  in  Holy  Scripture  that 
there  will  be  a  very  general  falling  away 
from  Christianity,  or  an  apostasy,  before  the 
second  coming  of  our  Lord.  (2  Thess.  ii. 
3 ;  1  Tim.  iv.  1 ;  2  Tim.  iv.  3,  4.) 


APOSTLE 

In  the  Komish  Church  the  term  apostasy 
is  also  applied  to  a  renunciation  of  the 
monastic  vow. 

APOSTLE.  (ajTOCTToXor,  ajroorcXXm.)  A 
missionary,  messenger,  or  envoy.  The 
highest  order  in  the  ministry  were  at  first 
called  Apostles ;  but  the  term  is  now 
generally  confined  to  those  first  bishops  of 
the  Church  who  received  their  commission 
from  oiir  Blessed  Lordj  himself,  and  who 
were  distinguished  from  the  bishops  who 
succeeded  them,  by  their  having  acted 
under  the  immediate  inspiration  of  the 
Holy  Spirit,  and  by  their  having  frequently 
exercised  the  power  of  working  miracles. 

L  Their  number  and  names.  Lists  of  the 
Apostles  are  given  in  three  of  the  gospels, 
and  there  is  also  a  list  in  the  Acts  of  the 
Apostles  (chap.  i.).  Comparing  these  lists 
together  we  find  that  the  first  five  names  are 
but  little  changed  in  order.  St.  Peter  is 
always  the  first,  St.  Philip  always  the  fifth. 
In  St.  Matthew's  and  St.  Luke's  Gospels,  St. 
Andrew  is  mentioned  directly  after  St.  Peter ; 
in  St.  Mark's  Gospel  and  in  the  Acts,  SS. 
James  and  John  are  placed  before  him.  St. 
James  the  Less  is  in  each  case  placed  ninth, 
while  between  him  and  St.  PhUip,-  -SS. 
Bartholomew,  Thomas,  and  Matthew  are 
differently  arranged.  Judas  Iscariot  is 
named  last  in  the  three  gospels,  and  before 
him  are  placed  in  different  order,  Judas  the 
brother  of  James,  called  also  Thaddajus,  and 
Lebbasus,  and  Simon  Zelotes,  called  also 
Simon  the  Canaanite.  Though  it  is  interest- 
ing thus  to  compare  the  order  in  which  the 
Apostles  are  mentioned,  it  is  to  be  remem- 
bered that  they  had  equal  power;  a  fact 
which  is  emphatically  asserted  by  St.  Paul. 
After  the  Ascension,  St?  Matthias  was 
chosen  into  the  place  of  Judas  Iscariot,  as  it 
was  necessary  that  "another  should  take 
his  bishopric."  This  was  done  by  solemn 
casting  of  lots,  after  prayer ;  but  after  the 
descent  of  the  Holy  Spirit  on  the  first 
Whitsunday  a  similar  ceremony  was  not 
required.  The  number  12  was  for  the  time 
kept  up,  and  some  time  after  the  martyrdom 
of  St.  James,  St.  Paul  was  named  an  Apostle, 
and  it  may  be  that  Barnabas,  called  by  the 
Church  an  Apostle,  was  so  appointed  after 
the  death  of  one  of  the  original  Apostles. 
But  even  if  there  were  more  than  the 
original  number  of  the  Apostles,  it  may  be 
said  that  they  were  called  the  twelve,  as  the 
name  of  their  college,  so  to  speak ;  in  the 
same  way  as  the  LXXII.  translators  of  the 
Old  Testament  into  Greek  are  called  the 
LXX. 

II.  Their  commission.  Ova  Lord's  first 
commission  to  his  Apostles  was  in  the  third 
year  of  his  public  ministry,  about  eight 
months  after  their  solemn  election ;  at 
which  time  he  sent  them  out  by  two  and 


APOSTLE 

two.  (Matt.  s.  5,  &c.)  They  were  to 
make  no  provision  of  money  for  their  sub- 
sistence in  their  journey,  but  to  expect  it 
from  those  to  whom  they  preached.  They 
were  to  declare  that  the  kingdom  of  heaven, 
or  the  Messiah,  was  at  hand,  and  to  confirm 
their  doctrine  by  miracles.  They  were  to 
avoid  going  either  to  the  Gentiles  or  the 
Samaritans,  and  to  confine  their  preaching 
to  the  people  of  Israel.  In  obedience  to 
their  Master,  the  Apostles  went  into  all  the 
parts  of  Palestine  inhabited  by  the  Jews, 
preaching  the  gospel,  and  working  miracles. 
(Mark  vi.  12.)  The  evangelical  history  is 
silent  as  to  the  particular  circumstances 
attending  this  first  preaching  of  the  Apostles, 
and  only  informs  us,  that  they  returned, 
and  told  their  Master  aU  that  they  had  done. 
(Luke  ix.  10.) 

Their  second  commission,  just  before 
our  Lord's  ascension  into  heaven,  was  of 
a  more  extensive  and  particular  nature. 
They  were  now  not  to  confine  their  preach- 
ing to  the  Jews,  but  to  "  go  and  teach  all 
nations,  baptizing  them  in  the  name  of  the 
Father,  and  of  the  Son,  and  of  the  Holy 
Ghost."  (Matt,  xxviii.  19,  20.)  Accord- 
ingly they  began  publicly,  after  the  descent 
of  the  Holy  Ghost  on  the  Day  of  Pentecost, 
to  exercise  the  office  of  their  ministry, 
working  miracles  daily  in  proof  of  their 
mission,  and  making  great  numbers  of  con- 
verts to  the  Christian  faith.  (Acts  ii.  42- 
47.)  This  alarmed  the  Jevsish  Sanhedrim ; 
whereupon  the  Apostles  were  apprehended, 
and,  being  examined  before  the  high  priest 
and  elders,  were  commanded  not  to  preach 
any  more  in  the  name  of  Christ.  But  this 
injimction  did  not  terrify  them  from  per- 
sisting in  the  duty  of  their  calling ;  for  they 
continued  daily,  in  the  temple,  and  in 
private  houses,  teaching  and  preaching  the 
gospel.    (Acts  ii.  46.) 

III.  Their  subsequent  labours.  It  is 
stated  by  Clemens  Alexandrinus  that  after 
the  Apostles  had  exercised  their  ministry 
for  twelve  years  in  Palestine,  they  resolved 
to  disperse  themselves  in  different  parts  of 
the  world,  and  agreed  to  determine  by  lot 
what  parts  each  should  take.  But  there  is 
no  reference  made  in  Holy  Scripture  to 
casting  lots  after  the  election  of  St.  Matthias, 
which  was  before  the  descent  of  the  Holy 
Spirit ;  although  the  custom  under  some 
circumstances  lasted  in  the  Christian  Chvtrch 
till  the  seventh  century.  (Bingham,  Eccles. 
Ant.  iv.  1.)  St.  Paxil,  we  know  from 
the  Acts  of  the  Apostles,  worked  in  Asia 
Minor,  Macedonia,  Arabia,  Greece,  and 
Italy,  and  according  to  tradition  he  went 
also  to  Spain,  Graul  and  Britain.  Tra- 
dition also  associates  St.  Peter  and  St.  Jude 
mth  Mesopotamia  (Turkey  in  Asia);  St. 
Bartholomew  and  St.  Jude  with  Persia  ;  St. 


APOSTOLIC 


45' 


Bartholomew  and  St.  Thomas  with  Judzea  ; 
St.  Andrew  with  Thrace  (I'urkey  in  Europe) 
and  Soythia ;  St.  Simon  Zelotes  with  North 
Africa ;  St.  Matthew  with  Ethiopia ;  and 
St.  John  with  Asia  Minor.  St.  James  the 
Younger,  spent  his  life  in  Jud^a,  as  bishop 
of  the  Church  at  Jerusalem,  and  suffered 
martyrdom  a  short  time  before  the  destruc- 
tion of  the  holy  city.  It  has  generally 
been  believed  that  all  the  Apostles,  except 
St.  John,  suffered  martyrdom ;  but  with 
regard  to  this  there  is  no  evidence.  (See 
Robertson,  Ch.  Hist.  i.  p.  1-4.)  Another 
account  of  the  work  of  the  Apostles  is  given. 
in  Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  vol.  i.  p.  38. 

The  several  Apostles  are  usually  repre- 
sented with  their  respective  badges  or  at- 
tributes ;  St.  Peter  with  the  keys ;  St.  Paul 
with  a  sword;  St.  Andrew  with  a  cross; 
St.  James  the  Less  with  a  fuller's  pole ;  St. 
John  with  a  cup,  and  a  winged  serpent 
flying  out  of  it ;  St.  Bartholomew  with  a 
knife;  St.  Philip  with  a  long  staff,  whose- 
upper  end  is  formed  into  a  cross ;  St.  Thomas 
with  a  lance;  St.  Matthew  with  a  hatchet; 
St.  Matthias  with  a  battle-axe ;  St.  James 
the  Greater  with  a  pilgrim's  staff,  and  a 
gourd-bottle ;  St.  Simon  with  a  saw :  and 
St.  Jude  with  a  club.  [H.] 
APOSTLES'  CREED.  (See  Creeds.) 
APOSTOLIC,  APOSTOLICAL,  some- 
thing that  relates  to  the  Apostles,  or  descends 
from  them.  Thus  we  say,  the  apostolical  age, 
apostolical  character,  apostolical  doctrine, 
constitutions,  traditions,  &c.  In  the  primi- 
tive Church  it  was  an  appellation  given  to 
aU  such  Churches  as  were  founded  by  the 
Apostles,  and  even  to  the  bishops]  of  those 
Churches,  as  the  reputed  successors  of  the 
Apostles.  These  were  confined  to  four : 
Rome,  Alexandria,  Antioch,  and  Jerusalem. 
In  succeeding  ages,  the  other  Churches 
assumed  the  same  title,  on  account,  princi- 
pally, of  the  conformity  of  their  doctrine 
with  that  of  the  Churches  which  were 
apostolical  by  foundation,  and  because  all 
bishops  held  themselves  successors  of  the 
Apostles,  or  acted  in  their  respective  dioceses 
with  the  authority  of  apostles.  The  first 
time  the  term  apostolical  is  attributed  to 
bishops,  is  in  a  letter  of  Clovis  to  the 
Council  of  Orleans,  held  in  511 ;  though 
that  king  does  not  in  it  expressly  denomi-  , 
nate  them  apostolical,  but  apostolicd  sede 
dignissimi,  highly  worthy  of  the  apostolical 
see.  In  581,  Guntram  calls  the  bishops, 
assembled  at  M§,con,  apostolical  pontiffs. 
In  progress  of  time,  the  bishop  of  Rome 
increasing  in  power  above  the  rest,  and  the 
three  patriarchates  of  Alexandria,  Antioch, 
and  Jerusalem  having  fallen  into  the  hands 
of  the  Saracens,  the  title  apostolical  came  to 
be  restricted  to  the  pope  and  his  Church 
alone.     At  length  some  of  the  popes,  and 


46 


APOSTOLICAL 


among  them  Gregory  tlie  Great,  not  content 
to  liold  the  title  by  this  tenure,  began  to 
insist  that  it  belonged  to  them  by  another 
and  peculiar  right,  as  the  successors  of  St. 
Peter.  In  1406,  the  Komish  Council  of 
Eheims  declared  that  the  pope  was  the  sole 
apostolical  primate  of  the  Universal  Church. 
APOSTOLICAL  CONSTITUTIONS 
AND  CANONS.  These  two  collections  of 
ecclesiastical  rules  and  formularies  were 
attributed,  in  the  early  ages  of  the  Church 
of  Eome,  to  Clement  of  Rome,  who  was 
supposed  to  have  committed  them  to  writing 
from  the  mouths  of  the  Apostles,  whose  words 
they  pretended  to  record.  The  authority 
thus  claimed  for  these  writings  has,  how- 
ever, been  entirely  disproved;  and  it  is 
generally  supposed  by  critics,  that  they  were 
chiefly  compiled  during  the  second  and 
third  centuries ;  or  that,  at  least  the  greater 
part  must  be  assigned  to  a  period  shortly 
before  the  first  Nicene  Council.  We  find 
indeed  references  to  them  in  the  writings 
of  Eusebius,  Epiphanius,  and  Athanasius, 
writers  of  the  third  and  fourth  centuries  ; 
but  it  is  the  general  opinion  that  they  did 
not  attain  their  complete  form  till  the 
fifth  century  (Pearson,  Vind.  Ignat.,  pt. 
I.  c.  94 ;  Usher,  Cotel.  Pair.  Apost,  vol. 
ii.  p.  220.)  I.  The  Constitutions  are  com- 
prised in  eight  books.  In  these  the  Apos- 
tles are  frequently  introduced  as  speakers. 
They  contain  rules  and  regulations  con- 
cerning the  duties  of  Christians  in  general, 
the  constitution  of  the  Church,  the  offices 
and  duties  of  ministers,  and  the  celebra- 
tion of  Divine  worship.  The  tone  of 
morality  which  runs  through  them  is  severe 
and  ascetic.  They  forbid  the  use  of  all 
personal  decorations  and  attention  to  appear- 
ance, and  prohibit  the  reading  of  the  works 
of  heathen  authors.  They  enjoin  Christians 
to  assemble  twice  every  day  in  the  church 
for  prayers  and  psalmody,  to  observe  various 
fasts  and  festivals,  and  to  keep  the  Sabbath 
(i.e.  the  seventh  day  of  the  week)  as  well 
as  the  Lord's  day.  They  require  extra- 
ordinary marks  of  respect  and  reverence 
towards  the  ministers  of  religion ;  com- 
manding Christians  to  honour  a  bishop  as  a 
king  or  a  prince,  and  even  as  a  kind  of  God 
upon  earth,  to  render  to  him  absolute 
obedience,  to  pay  him  tribute,  and  to  ap- 
proach him  through  the  deacons  or  servants 
of  the  Church,  as  we  come  to  God  only 
through  Christ !  This  latter  kind  of  (pro- 
fane) comparison  is  carried  to  a  still  greater 
extent,  for  the  deaconesses  are  declared  to 
resemble  the  Holy  Spirit,  inasmuch  as  they 
are  not  able  to  do  anything  without  the 
deacons.  Presbyters  are  said  to  represent 
the  Apostles;  and  the  rank  of  Christian 
teachers  is  declared  to  be  higher  than  that 
of  magistrates  and  princes.    We  find  here, 


APOSTOLICAL 

also,  a  complete  liturgy  or  form  of  worship 
for  Christian  churches  ;  containing  not  only 
a  description  of  ecclesiastical  ceremonies,  but 
the  prayers  to  be  used  at  their  celebration. 

This  general  description  of  the  contents 
of  the  books  of  Constitutions  is  alone  enough 
to  prove  that  they  are  no  productions  of  the 
apostolic  age.  Mention  also  occurs  of  several 
subordinate  ecclesiastical  officers,  such  as 
readers  and  exorcists,  who  were  not  intro- 
duced into  the  Church  until  the  third 
century.  And  there  are  manifest  contradic- 
tions between  several  parts  of  the  work. 
The  general  style  in  which  the  Constitutions 
are  written  is  such  as  had  become  prevalent 
during  the  third  century. 

It  is  useless  to  inquire,  who  was  the  real 
author  of  this  work;  but  the  date  and 
probable  design  of  it  are  of  more  importance, 
and  may  be  more  easily  ascertained.  Epi- 
phanius, towards  the  end  of  the  fourth 
century,  appears  to  be  the  first  author  who 
speaks  of  these  books  under  their  present 
title.  Apostolical  Constitutions.  But  he 
refers  to  the  work  oidy  as  one  containing 
much  edifying  matter,  without  including  it 
among  the  writings  of  the  Apostles ;  and 
indeed  he  expressly  says  that  many  persons 
had  doubted  of  its  genuineness.  On  the 
whole,  it  appears  probable,  from  internal 
evidence,  that  the  Apostolical  Constitutions 
were  compiled  during  the  reigns  of  the 
heathen  emperors,  towards  the  end  of  the 
third  century,  or  at  the  beginning  of  the 
fourth ;  and  that  the  compilation  was  the 
work  of  some  one  writer  (probably  a  bishop) 
of  the  Eastern  Church.  ,  The  advancement 
of  episcopal  dignity  andj  power  appears  to 
have  been  the  chief  design  of  the  work. 

II.  The  Canons  relate  chiefly  to  various 
particulars  of  ecclesiastical  polity  and  Chris- 
tian worship ;  the  regulations  which  they 
contain  being,  for  the  most  part,  sanctioned 
with  the  threatening  of  deposition  and  ex- 
communication against  offenders.  The  first 
allusion  to  this  work  by  name'  is  found  in 
the  Acts  of  the  Council  which  assembled  at 
Constantinople  in  the  year  394,  under  the 
presidency  of  Nectarius,  bishop  of  that  see. 
But  there  are  expressions  in  earher  councils, 
and  writers  of  the  same  century,  which 
appear  to  refer  to  the  Canons,  although  not 
named.  In  the  beginning  of  the  sixth  cen- 
tury, fifty  of  these  Canons  were  translated 
from  the  Greek  into  Latin  by  the  Roman 
abbot  Dionysius  the  Younger ;  and,  about 
the  same  time,  thirty-five  others  were  ap- 
pended to  them  in  a  collection  made  by 
John,  patriarch  of  Constantinople.  Since 
that  time,  the  whole  number  have  been 
regarded  as  genuine  in  the  East ;  whUe  only 
the  first  fifty  have  been  treated  with  equal 
respect  in  the  West.  It  appears  highly 
probable  that  the  original  collection  was 


APOSTOLICAL 

made  about  the  middle  of  the  third  century, 
or  somewhat  later,  in  one  of  the  Asiatic 
Churches.  The  author  may  have  had  the 
same  design  as  that  which  appears  to  have 
influenced  the  compiler  of  the  Apostolical 
Constitutions.  The  eighty-fifth  Canon 
speaks  of  the  Constitutions  as  sacred  books ; 
and  from  a  comparison  of  the  two  books,  it 
is  plain  that  they  are  either  the  production 
of  one  and  the  same  writer,  or  that,  at  least, 
the  two  authors  were  contemporary,  and 
had  a  good  xmderstanding  with  each  other. 
The  rules  and  regulations  contauied  in  the 
Canons  are  such  as  were  gradually  intro- 
duced and  established  during  the  second  and 
third  centuries.  In  the  canon  or  list  of 
sacred  books  of  the  New  Testament,  given 
in  this  work,  the  Eevelation  of  St.  John  is 
omitted ;  but  the  two  Epistles  of  St.  Clement 
and  Apostohcal  Constitutions  are  inserted. — 
Dr.  C.  W.  J.  Augusti,  Benkwurdigheiten 
aus  der  Ghristlichen  Archdologie,  vol.  i. ; 
Krabbe ;  Dr.  J.  S.  V.  Drey ;  Gieseler,  i. 
259 ;  Stubbs'  MosJieim,  i.  97,  252  et  seq. ; 
Smith's  Diet.  Christ.  Antiq.  i.  12. 

APOSTOLICAL  FATHERS.  An  appella- 
tion usually  given  to  the  writers  of  the  first 
century,  who  employed  their  pens  in  the 
cause  of  Christianity.  Of  these  writers, 
Cotelerius  (Paris,  1672),  and  after  him  Le 
Clerc  (Amsterd.  1724),  have  pubUshed  a 
collection  in  two  vohmies,  accompanied  both 
with  their  own  armotations  and  the  remarks 
of  other  learned  men.  Among  later  editions 
may  be  particularly  mentioned  that  by  the 
Eev.  Dr.  Jacobson  (1847),  Eegius  Professor 
of  Divinity  at  Oxford,  and  afterwards  Bishop 
of  Chester,  which,  however,  does  not 
include  Barnabas  or  Hermas.  The  Epis- 
tles of  Clement  have  been  edited  by  Bishop 
Lightfoot  (1869).  See  also  'The  Gen- 
uine Epistles  of  the  Apostolic  Fathers,' 
by  Archbishop  Wake,  and  a  translation  of 
them  in  one  volume  8vo;  by  the  Eev.  Temple 
ChevaUier,  B.D.,  formerly  Hulsean  lecturer 
in  the  University  of  Cambridge.  Also 
TiUemont,  Memoires  pour  servir  a  Vhistoire 
de  VEglise,  vol.  i.,  pt.  iii.,  p.  1043;  vol. 
ii.,  pt.  ii.,  p.  287,  &c.  The  Apostolical 
Fathers  were,  (1)  Clement,  bishop  of  Eome, 
probably  the  same  Clemens  referred  to  by 
St.  Paul  (PhU..  iv.  3).  His  first  epistle  was 
written  to  reprove  the  spirit  of  schism  in 
the  Corinthian  Church,  and  is  called  by 
Eusebius  eViOToX?;  ficydXi;  re  Koi  Oav/jAa-ia. 
The  second  epistle  has  no  title,  and  is 
rarely  referred  to  by  the  Church  historian 
(Euseb.  Sist.  iii.  38)  ;  (2)  Ignatius,  bishop 
of  Antioch,  supposed  to  have  been  martyred 
about  A.D.  107.'  Of  twelve  epistles  ascribed 
to  him,  five  are  doubtless  spurious ;  two  of 
these  were  addressed  to  St.  John,  and  one 
to  the  Virgin  Mary.  Of  the  remaining 
seven,  there  is  little  doubt  as  to  the  authen- 


APOSTOLICAL 


47 


ticity,  and  they  are  referred  to  by  Irena3us, 
Origen,  Eusebius,  Ohrysostom,  and  many 
other  early  writers.  (3)  Polycarp,  bishop 
of  Smyrna,  martyred  at  an  extreme  age  in 
the  middle  of  the  second  century.  His 
epistle  was  addressed  to  the  Philippians,  and 
is  spoken  of  in  high  terms  by  Irenaius  (adv. 
Eair.  iii.  3),  and  often  quoted  by  Eusebius. 

(4)  Hermas,  perhaps  the  same  mentioned 
by  St.  Paul  (Eom.  xvi.  14),  but  more  pro- 
bably the  brother  of  Pius,  the  bishop  of 
Eome.  The  authorship  of  the  '  Shepherd  of 
Hermas '  is  really  unknown,  but  the  work  is 
quoted  by  many  of  the  most  ancient  writers. 

(5)  Barnabas,  clearly  a  different  person  from 
the  companion  of  St.  Paul.  The  epistle 
which  goes  by  his  name  was  probably  written 
early  in  the  second  century.  This,  however, 
and  the  '  Shepherd  of  Hermas,'  are  very  far 
removed  from  the  apostolic  dignity  of  the 
epistles  mentioned  above,  than  which  a  more 
admirable  appendix  to  the  pure  word  of  God, 
and  a  more  trustworthy  comment  on  the 
principles  taught  by  inspired  men,  cannot 
be  conceived.  As  eye-witnesses  of  the  order 
and  discipline  of  the  Church,  while  all  was 
fresh  and  new  from  the  hands  of  the  apostles, 
their  testimony  forms  the  very  summit  of 
uninspired  authority.  None  could  better 
know  these  things  than  those  who  lived  and 
wrote  at  the  very  time.  None  deserve  a 
greater  reverence  than  they  who  proclaimed 
the  Gospel,  while  the  echo  of  inspired 
tongues  yet  lingered  in  the  ears  of  the 
people.    [H.] 

APOSTOLICAL  SUCCESSION.  (See 
Bishops.)  We  learn  from  the  gospels  that 
our  Lord  Jesus  Christ  chose  from  among 
His  disciples  twelve  Apostles  whom  He  sent 
forth  to  preach.  After  His  resurrection  from 
the  dead  He  gave  to  the  eleven  a  more 
extended  commission.  They  were  to  evan- 
gelise all  nations;  to  be  witnesses  con- 
cerning Christ  unto  the  uttermost  part  of 
the  earth  (Matt,  xxviii.  19;  Acts  i.  8). 
"As  my  Father  hath  sent  me,"  He  said, 
"  even  so  send  I  you"  (John  xx.  21).  Other 
chosen  men  were  associated  with  them  in 
their  office ;  particularly  St.  Matthias  and 
St.  Paul,  whose  call  to  the  apostolate  was 
the  immediate  act  of  Christ  Himself. 

Under  the  direction  of  the  Holy  Ghost,  the 
Apostles  became  the  founders  and  builders 
up  of  the  Church.  They  ordained  other 
ministers  to  whom  they  committed  sub- 
ordinate parts  of  their  work.  There  are 
mentioned  in  the  Acts,  presbyters  (to  whom 
the  name  itrla-Konoi,  bishops,  is  also  given 
in  the  New  Testament),  and  deacons,  as 
having  been  thus  appointed  by  the  Apostles 
(Acts  vi.  3,  xiv.  23,  xx.  17,  28). 

AVhen  we  turn  to  the  records  of  the  early 
Church,  we  find  that  by  the  middle  of  the 
second  century  there  were  everywhere  three 


48 


APOSTOLICAL 


classes  of  ministers,  bishops,  priests  (or 
presbyters),  and  deacons.  The  names 
bishop,  and  presbyter,  were  now  distributed 
to  different  persons.  The  right  of  ordina- 
tion belonged  to  bishops,  and  by  episcopal 
ordination  a  succession  of  ministers  was  kept 
up.  This  confessedly  was  the  rule  of  the 
transmission  of  holy  orders  throughout  the 
universal  Church. 

The  question  then  arises,  what  is  the 
connexion  of  this  fact  with  the  former  fact 
of  the  ministry  of  the  Apostles  ?  There  is 
clearly  a  presumption,  in  the  absence  of 
testimony  to  the  contrary,  that  a  rule  uni- 
versally followed  at  so  early  a  period  must 
have  been  in  accordance  with  the  Apostles' 
intention  and  practice.  "  What  is  held  by 
the  universal  Church,  and  not  ordained  by 
any  council,  but  has  always  been  retained 
in  the  Church,  is  to  be  believed  to  have 
come  down  from  apostolical  authority."  (St. 
Augustine,  quoted  by  Bishop  Harold  Browne 
On  the  Articles,  p.  549,  11  ed.)  The  phrase 
Apostolical  Succession  expresses  the  belief 
that  the  rule  of  episcopal  ordination  and 
government  was  in  its  essence  no  fresh 
departure  in  the  history  of  the  organisation 
of  the  Church,  but  rather  the  continuance 
of  the  order  which  prevailed  from  the  begin- 
ning ;  the  Episcopate  being  "  historically  the 
continuation  in  its  permanent  elements  of 
the  Apostolate "  (Haddan,  Did.  of  Christ. 
Antiq.  v.  i.  p.  212) ;  so  that  bishops  may 
be  called  the  successors  of  the  Apostles. 
That  this  belief  prevailed  generally  among 
Christians  at  a  very  early  time  is  well 
known.  It  is  sufficient  here  to  refer  to  the 
often  quoted  testimony  of  TertuUian  (De 
Prsescript.  c.  32), "  Let  [the  heretics]  produce 
the  original  records  of  their  churches:  let 
them  unfold  the  roll  of  their  bishops  running 
down  in  due  succession  from  the  beginning 
in  such  a  manner  that  their  first  distin- 
guished bishop  (primus  Ule  episcopus)  shall 
be  able  to  show  for  his  ordainer  and  pre- 
decessor some  one  of  the  Apostles  or  of 
apostolic  men, — a  man  moreover  who  con- 
tinued steadfast  with  the  Apostles.  For  this 
is  the  manner  in  which  the  apostolic 
churches  transmit  their  registers."  (Trans- 
lation in  Ante-Nicene  Library.) 

There  are  not  wanting  facts  in  the  history 
of  the  Apostolic  age  itself  which  confirm 
this  inference.  Str  James,  the  "  brother  " 
of  the  Lord,  superintended  as  bishop  the 
Mother  Church  of  Jerusalem.  (Acts  xii. 
17  ;  XV.  13 ;  xxi.  18.)  Timothy  and  Titus 
were  appointed  by  St.  Paul  to  exercise  a  like 
superintendence,  the  one  at  Ephesus,  the 
other  in  Crete.  The  angels  of  the  Seven 
Chm'ches  of  Asia  addressed  by  St.  John 
seem  to  have  occupied  a  like  position.  (See 
Abp.  Trench,  Commentary  on  the  Seven  Epp., 
pp.  47  flg.-;  Lee  on  Eev.  i.  20,  and  Note  P 


APOSTOLICAL 

in  Speaker's  Commentary.  For  objections. 
Bishop  Lightfoot,  On  the  Philippians,  pp. 
199  flg.)  These  persons  in  the  lifetime  of 
some  of  the  Apostles  exercised  locally  a 
superintendence  like  that  which  the  Apostles 
exercised  more  widely.  The  earliest  Chris- 
tian writer  next  to  the  writers  of  the  New 
Testament,  St.  Clement  of  Eome,  speaks  of 
the  provision  which  the  Apostles  made  for 
keeping  up  a  succession  in  the  ministry.  In 
the  Epistle  of  Clement,  indeed,  as  apparently 
in  the  recently  discovered  Teaching  of  the 
Twelve  Apostles,  the  title  inia-Koiros,  hishop, 
is  still  given  to  presbyters.  But  Clement  (1 
Ep.  ad  Cor.  c.  44)  speaks  of  the  appointment 
of  presbyters  by  the  Apostles,  "  or  afterwards 
by  other  eminent  men  "  (KaracrraBevras  im" 
€K€ivoJv  ^  fiera^v  V0'  erepav  iWoytfiav 
dvSpav),  who  therefore  must  have  exercised 
this  part  of  the  apostolic  office.  That  the 
Apostles  were  not  localised,  or  diocesan, 
bishops  may  very  well  be  conceded.  If  St. 
James  of  Jerusalem  was  an  Apostle,  an 
opinion  not  generally  entertained,  he  was 
an  exception  to  the  rule.  The  localisation 
of  the  episcopate  is  a  matter^of  Church  order 
and  arrangement,  not  belonging  to  the 
essence  of  the  office.  (In  Ecclesiast.  Pol. 
bk.  vii.  diocesan  bishops  are  called  "  Bishops 
by  restraint,"  the  Apostles  "  Bishops  at 
large.")  Some  of  the  high  functions  com- 
mitted to  the  Apostles  may  have  been 
peculiar  to  them,  and  not  transmissible  to 
others.  Timothy  and  Titus  may  perhaps 
be  more  correctly  described  as  apostolic 
delegates  than  as  diocesan  bishops.  But  the 
functions  which  they  were  commissioned  to- 
perform  were  the  functions  of  a  bishop. 
That  bishops  should  have  sometimes  been 
called  presbyters,  as  by  IrenKus  and  Au- 
gustine, is  no  bar  to  the  belief  that  the 
episcopal  office  is  essentially  the  higher  one. 
St.  Peter  (1  Pet.  v.  1)  caUed  hunself  a  fellow- 
presbyter.  All  this  consists  with  the  belief 
that  certain  important  functions  have  been 
committed  to  the  episcopal  order  in  suc- 
cession to  the  apostolate.  "A  bishop," 
writes  Hooker,  "  is  a  minister  of  God,  imto 
whom,  with  permanent  continuance,  there 
is  given  not  only  power  of  administering  the 
word  and  sacraments,  which  power  other- 
presbyters  have ;  but  also  a  further  power 
to  ordain  ecclesiastical  persons,  and  a  power 
of  chiefty  in  government  over  presbyters 
as  well  as  laymen,  a  power  to  be  by  way  of 
jurisdiction  a  pastor  even  to  pastors  them- 
selves."   (Eccl.  Pol.  bk.  vii.  2.) 

The  theory  that  episcopacy  arose  out  of 
the  presbyterate,  and  was  adopted  in  order 
to  check  the  growth  of  schisms  in  the  Church, 
was  put  forth  by  Jerome.  (See  Bp.  Lightfoot,. 
On  the  Philippians,  pp.  205,  206,  227,  &c., 
who  maintains  substantially  the  same  view.)' 
According  to  this  view  the   presbyterate 


APOSTOLICI 

would  be  historically  the  link  between 
episcopacy  and  the  Apostles.  That  the  state- 
ments of  Jerome,  and  of  Hilary  the  Deacon, 
are  not  conclusive  is  shown  by  Bp.  Harold 
Browne,  On  the  Articles,  pp.  553  flg.,  and 
Haddan,  Diet,  of  Ch.  Antiq.  vol.  i.  p.  212. 
(See  also  Bp.  Wordsworth,  Tlieoph.  Anglic,  c. 
xi. ;  Prof.  J.  J.  Blunt,  Early  Ch.  Hist.  c.  iv., 
and  the  references  in  Hook's  Lives  of  the 
Alps,  of  Canterbury,  vol.  ix.  p.  198.) 

The  promoters  of  the  English  Reformation 
were  careful  to  preserve  in  the  English 
Church  the  ancient  episcopal  succession,  and 
thus,  as  they  believed,  the  apostolical  suc- 
cession also.  There  has  been  no  break  in 
the  regular  transmission  of  holy  orders  in 
the  English  Church.  By  all  Church  writers 
of  note  episcopacy  is  regarded  as  a  sacred 
institution  possessing  the  highest  sanction. 
"The  threefold  ministry,"  writes  Bishop 
Lightfoot,  "  can  be  traced  to  apostolic  direc- 
tion ;  and  short  of  an  express  statement  we 
can  possess  no  better  assurance  of  a  Divine 
appointment,  or  at  least  a  Divine  sanction." 
(On  the  Philippians,  p.  267.)  Episcopal 
succession  is  carefully  guarded  by  all  who 
have  authority  in  the  English  Church,  or  in 
Churches  which  are  in  communion  with  her. 
"  "We  must  conclude  with  Hooker,"  writes 
Bishop  Harold  Browne,  " '  If  anything  in 
the  Church's  government,  surely  the  first 
institution  of  bishops  was  from  Heaven,  even 
of  God.'  And  with  Bishop  Hall,  '  What 
inevitable  necessity  may  do,  we  now  dispute 
not,'  yet '  for  the  main  substance,'  episcopacy 
'  is  utterly  indispensable,  and  must  so  con- 
tinue to  the  world's  end.' "  (  On  the  Articles, 
p.  568.)     [J.  G.  H.] 

APOSTOLICI,  or  APOSTOLI.  I.  A  sect 
of  the  twelfth  century,  whom  St.  Bernard 
assailed  with  great  earnestness.  (St.  Ber- 
nard,- opp.  vol.  iv.  p.  1495,  ed.  Mabillon.) 
Their  desire  was  to  exemplify  in  their 
conduct  the  apostolic  mode  of  living.  They 
were  for  the  most  part  people  of  lowly  con- 
dition, but  they  had  friends  and  supporters 
in  every  rank  and  order.  They  allowed 
their  hair  and  beards  to  grow  long ;  deemed 
it  unlawful  to  take  an  oath:  preferred 
celibacy,  calling  themselves  the  chaste 
brethren  and  sisters;  yet  each  man,  after 
the  maimer  of  the  Apostles,  as  they  asserted, 
had  a  spiritual  sister  with  whom  he  lived 
in  a  domestic  relation. — Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  vol.  iL  p.  159. 

II.  Another  sect,  perhaps  the  offspring 
of  the  above,  was  founded  by  Gerhard  Sagar- 
elli  of  Parma,  who  was  burned  at  the  stake 
A.D.  1300.  For  he  not  only  held  the  ideas 
of  the  Apostolici,  but  also  denounced  the 
"  deformed  Eoman  Church,"  and  foretold  its 
speedy  downfall,  and  the  rise  of  a  holier 
Church.  His  followers  moreover  were  fa- 
natical  communists,  dangerous  to  society 


APPEAL 


49 


like  the  Anabaptists.  His  successor,  Dul- 
cinos  of  Novara,  was  even  more  bold  and 
energetic  in  his  preaching.  He  was  tortured 
to  death,  together  with  Margaretta,  his 
spiritual  sister,  a.d.  1307. — Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  vol.  ii.  p.  246. 

APOSTOOLIANS.  A  party  of  the  Men- 
nonites  which  derived  its  name  from  Samuel 
Apostool  of  Amsterdam,  1664.  Apostool 
defended  the  original  doctrines  of  the  Men- 
nonites  against  Galenus,  who  held  different 
views  with  regard  to  the  Divine  nature  of 
Christ,  &c. — Mosheim,  iii.  459.     (See  Men- 

APOTACTIT^,orAPOTACTICL  Here- 
tics who  sprang  from  the  Manichseans. 
Severe  laws  had  been  passed  against  the 
Manichaeans,  especially  one  of  Theodosius 
the  Great  (a.d.  381)  which,  pronouncing 
them  infamous,  deprived  them  of  all  the 
rights  of  citizens.  To  avoid  this  severity 
the  Manichajans  assimied  various  names,  as 
Encratites,  Saccophori,  Apotaotics.  The 
word  is  derived  from  aTroTaa-a-a,  and  implied 
a  renunciation  of  all  their  possessions,  after 
the  manner  of  the  Apostles.  Hence  they 
have  been  also  called  Apostolici. 

APPARITOR.  Apparitors  (so  called  from 
the  principal  branch  of  their  office,  which 
consists  in  summoning  persons  to  appear) 
are  officers  appointed  to  execute  the  orders 
and  decrees  of  the  ecclasiastical  courts.  The 
proper  business  and  employment  of  an 
apparitor  is  to  attend  in  court ;  to  receive 
such  commands  as  the  judge  shall  please  to 
issue  forth ;  to  convene  and  cite  the  defen- 
dants into  court;  to  admonish  or  cite  the 
parties  to  produce  witnesses,  and  the  like. 
Apparitors  are  recognised  by  the  138th 
English  Canon,  which  wholly  relates  to 
them. 

APPEAL.  The  provocation  of  a  cause 
from  an  inferior  to  a  superior  judge.  (1 
Kings  xviii. ;  Acts  xxv.)  Appeals  are 
divided  into  judicial  and  extra-judicial. 
Judicial  appeals  are  those  made  from  the 
actual  sentence  of  a  court  of  judicature. 
In  this  case  the  force  of  such  sentence  is 
sometimes  suspended  until  the  cause  is 
determined  by  the  superior  judge ;  but  that 
requires  an  order  of  either  the  inferior  or  su- 
perior court,  which.is  seldom  refused.  Occa- 
sionally it  is  so  by  Act  of  Parliament.  Extra- 
judicial appeals  are  those  made  from  extra- 
judicial acts,  by  which  a  person  either  is,  or 
is  likely  to  be,  wronged.  He  therefore  resorts 
to  the  legal  protection  of  a  superior  judge. 
By  the  civil  law,  appeals  ought  to  be  made 
gradatim ;  but  by  the  canon  law,  as  it  existed 
before  the  Reformation,  they  might  be  made 
omisso  medio,  and  immediately  to  the  pope ; 
who  was  reputed  to  be  the  ordinary  judge  of  all 
Christians  in  all  causes,  having  a  concurrent 
power  with  all  ordinaries.     Appeals  to  the 

E 


50 


APPEAL 


pope  were  first  sent  from  England  to  Eome 
in  the  reign  of  King  Stephen,  by  the  pope's 
legate,  Henry  of  Blois,  bishop  of  Winchester 
(a.d.  1135-1154).  Prior  to  that  period, 
the  pope  was  not  permitted  to  enjoy  any 
appellate  jurisdiction  in  England.  William 
the  Conqueror  refused  to  do  him  homage. 
Anglo-Saxon  Dooms  do  not  so  much  as 
mention  the  pope's  name ;  and  the  laws  of 
Edward  the  Confessor  assert  the  royal 
supremacy  in  the  following  words :— "  Kex 
autem,  qui  vicarius  Summi  Regis  est,  ad 
hoc  constitutus  est,  ut  regnum  et  populum 
Domini,  et  super  omnia  sanotam  ecclesiam, 
regat  et  defendat  ab  injuriosis;  maleficos 
autem  destruat  et  evellat."  The  Penitential 
of  Archbishop  Theodore  (a.d.  668-690) 
contains  no  mention  of  appeals  to  Eome; 
and  in  the  reign  of  Henry  II.,  at  the  Council 
of  Clarendon  (a.d.  1164),  it  was  enacted, 
"  De  appellationibus  si  emerserint  ab  archi- 
diacono  debebit  procedi  ad  episcopum,  ab 
episcopo  ad  archiepiscopum,  et  si  archiepi- 
scopus  defuerit  in  justitia  exhibenda,  ad 
domiiium  regem  perveniendum  est  postremo, 
ut  prsecepto  ipsius  in  curia  archiepiscopi 
controyevsia  terminetur ;  ita  quod  non  debeat 
ijltra  procedi  absque  assensu  domini  regis." 
Notwithstanding  this  law,  and  the  statutes 
made  against  "  provisors "  in  the  reigns  of 
Edward  I.,  Edward  III.,  Bichard  II.,  and 
Henry  V.,  appeals  used  to  be  forwarded  to 
Eome  until  the  reign  of  Henry  VHI.,  when, 
■  by  the  statutes  of  the  24  Henry  VIII.  c.  12, 
and  the  25  Henry  VIII.  c.  19,  all  appeals 
to  the  pope  from  England  were  abolished. 
By  these  statutes,  appeals  were  to  be  finally 
determined  by  the  High  Court  of  Delegates, 
to  be  appointed  by  the  king  in  chancery 
under  the  great  seal.  This  jurisdiction  was, 
in  1832,  by  2  &  3  William  IV.  c.  92,  trans- 
ferred from  the  High  Court  of  Delegates  to 
the  Privy  Council,  and  to  the  Judicial  Com- 
mittee thereof  in  1833  ;  which  was  modified 
as  to  the  episcopal  members  in  1840,  1873, 
and  1876.  Their  "  report  or  recommenda- 
tion," when  sanctioned  by  the  Crown,  which 
is  a  matter  of  course  (see  below),  is  a  final 
judgment. 

The  Crown  used  to  have  the  power  to 
grant  a  commission  of  review  after  the  de- 
cision of  an  appeal  by  the  High  Court  of 
Delegates.  (26  Henry  VIII.  c.  1 ;  1  Eliz. 
c.  1,  Ooodman's  Case  in  Dyer's  Eeports.) 
This  prerogative  Queen  Mary  exercised  by 
granting  a  review  after  a  review  in  Good- 
man's case,  regarding  the  deanery  of  Wells. 
(See  Lord  Campbell's  Judgment  in  the 
Court  of  Queen's  Bench  in  Oorham,  t.  The 
Bisliop  of  Exeter,  in  Brodrick  &  Ere- 
mantle's  Ecc.  Judgments.)  But  commissions 
of  review  were  abolished  by  the  Act  of  1832, 
and  the  P.  C.  at  large  will  not  rehear. 
{MeVbert  v.  Furchas,  L.   E.  3  P.  C.  671.) 


APPEOPEIATIOK 

Consequently  the  decision  of  the  Judicial 
Committee  is  practically  final,  because  the 
Crown  itself  of  course  adopts  it.  (See  Courts 
Christian.')  It  is  a  remarkable  fact  that, 
although  the  statutes  for  restraint  of  appeals 
had  been  repealed  on  Queen  Mary's  accession, 
no  appeal  in  Goodman's  case  was  permitted 
to  proceed  out  of  England  to  the  pope.  The 
commissions  of  review  were  not  granted 
by  Queen  Mary  under  the  authority  of 
Protestant  enactments,  but  by  virtue  of 
the  common  law  regarding  the  regalities 
of  the  Crown  of  England.     [G.] 

APPELLANT.  Generally,  one  who  ap- 
peals from  the  decision  of  an  inferior  court 
to  a  superior.  Particularly  those  among  the 
French  clergy  were  called  appellants,  who 
appealed  from  the  bull  Unigenitus,  issued 
by  Pope  Clement  in  1713,  either  to  the  pope 
better  informed,  or  to  a  general  council. 
This  is  one  of  the  many  instances  in  which 
the  boasted  unity  of  the  Eoman  obedience 
has  been  signally  broken ;  the  whole  body 
of  the  French  clergy  and  the  several  monas- 
teries being  divided  into  appellants  and 
non-appellants. 

APPEOPEIATION  is  the  annexing  of  a 
benefice  to  the  use  of  a  spiritual  corporation. 
This  was  frequently  done  in  England  after 
the  Norman  Conquest.  Most  of  the  secular 
clergy  were  then  Englishmen;  and  most 
of  the  nobility,  bishops,  and  abbots  being 
Normans,  they  had  no  kind  of  regard  to  the 
secular  clergy,  but  reduced  them  as  low  as 
they  could  to  enrich  the  monasteries ;  and 
this  was  the  reason  of  so  many  appropriations. 
But  some  persons  are  of  opinion,  that  it  is  a 
question  undecided,  whether  princes  or  popes 
first  made  appropriations  :  though  the  oldest 
of  which  we  have  any  account  were  made  by 
princes ;  as,  for  instance,  by  the  English  kmgs, 
to  the  abbey  of  Crowland ;  bj'  William  the 
Conqueror,  to  Battle  Abbey ;  and  by  Hemy 
I.,  to  the  church  of  Salisbury.  It  is  true 
the  popes,  who  were  always  jealous  of  their 
usurped  supremacy  in  ecclesiastical  affairs, 
did  in  their  decretals  assume  this  power  to 
themselves,  and  granted  privileges  to  several 
religious  orders,  to  take  appropriations  from 
laymen :  but  in  the  same  grant  they  were 
usually  required  to  be  answerable  to  the 
bishop  in  spiritvMibus,  and  to  the  abbot  or 
prior  in  temporalihus,  which  was  the  com- 
mon form  of  appropriations  till  the  latter 
end  of  the  reign  of  Henry  II.  For  at  first 
those  grants  were  not  in  proprios  tisus:  it 
was  always  necessary  to  present  a  clerk  to 
the  bishop  upon  the  avoidance  of  a  benefice, 
who,  upon  his  institution,  became  vicar,  and 
for  that  reason  an  appropriation  and  a  rectory 
were  then  inconsistent.  But  because  the  for- 
mation of  an  appropriation  was  a  thing  merely 
spiritual,  the  patron  usually  petitioned  the 
bishop  to  appropriate  the  church;  but  the 


APPEOPEIATION 

]iing  -was  first  to  give  licence  to  the  monks 
that,  quantum  in  nobis  est,  the  bishop  might 
do  it.  The  king  being  supreme  ordinary, 
might  of  his  own  authority  make  an  appro- 
priation without  the  consent  of  the  bishop, 
though  this  was  seldom  done.  Appropria- 
tions at  first  were  made  only  to  spiritual 
persons,  such  as  were  qualified  to  perform 
Divine  service ;  then  by  degrees  they  were 
extended  to  spuitual  corporations,  as  deans 
-and  chapters;  and  lastly  to  priories,  upon 
the  pretence  that  they  had  to  support  hos- 
pitality ;  and  lest  preaching  should  by  this 
means  be  neglected,  an  invention  was  found 
•out  to  supply  that  defect  by  a  vicar,  as 
aforesaid ;  and  it  was  left  to  the  bishop  to 
be  a  moderator  between  the  monks  and  the 
■vicar,  for  his  maintenance  out  of  the  appro- 
priated tithes ;  for  the  bishop  cotild  compel 
the  monastery  to  which  the  church  was  ap- 
I)ropriated  to  set  out  a  convenient  portion  of 
tithes,  and  such  as  he  should  approve  for 
the  maintenance  of  the  vicar,  before  he 
•confirmed  the  appropriation. 

Is  is  true  the  bishops  in  those  days 
favomed  the  monks  so  much,  that  they 
connived  at  their  setting  out  a  portion  of 
small  tithes  for  the  vicar,  and  permitted 
them  to  reserve  the  great  tithes  to  them- 
selves. This  was  a  fault  intended  to  be 
remedied  by  the  statute  15  Rich.  II.  cap. 
6  ;  by  which  it  was  enacted,  that  in  every 
licence  made  of  an  appropriation  this  clause 
.should  be  contained,  viz.  that  the  diocesan 
should  ordain  that  the  vicar  shall  be  well  and 
sufficiently  endowed.  But  this  statute  was 
eluded ;  for  the  abbots  appointed  one  of 
their  own  monks  to  officiate ;  and  therefore 
the  parliament,  in  the  4th  year  of  Henry 
IV.  cap.  12,  provided  that  the  vicar  should 
be  a  secular  clergyman,  canonically  insti- 
tuted and  inducted  into  the  church,  and 
sufficiently  endowed;  and  that  no  regular 
should  be  made  vicar  of  a  church  appro- 
priate. But  long  before  the  making  of 
these  statutes  the  kings  of  England  made 
appropriation  of  the  churches  of  Feversham 
and  Milton  in  Kent,  and  other  churches,  to 
the  abbey  of  St.  Augustine  in  Canterbury, 
I)y  these  words:  " Concessimus,  &c.,  pro 
nobis,  &c.,  abbati  et  conventui,  &c.,  quod 
ipsi  ecclesias  predictas  appropriare  ac  eas 
sic  appropriatas  -in  proprios  usus  tenere 
possint  sibi  et  successoribus  in  perpetuum." 
The  like  was  done  by  several  of  the 
JSTorman  nobility,  who  came  over  with  the 
king,  upon  whom  he  bestowed  large  manors 
and  lands ;  and  out  of  which  they  found 
tithes  were  then  paid,  and  so  had  continued 
to  be  paid  even  from  the  time  they  were 
possessed  by  the  English :  but  they  did  not 
regard  their  law  of  tithing,  and  therefore 
they  held  it  reasonable  to  appropriate  all, 
3r  at  least  some  part  of,  those  tithes   to 


APSE 


51 


those  monasteries  which  they  had  founded, 
or  to  others  as  they  thought  fit ;  and  in 
such  cases  they  reserved  a  power  to  provide 
for  him  who  served  the  cure  ;  and  this  was 
usually  paid  to  stipendiary  curates.  But 
sometimes  the  vicarages  were  endowed,  and 
the  very  endowment  was  expressed  in  the 
grant  of  the  appropriation,  viz.  that  the 
church  shall  be  appropriated  upon  con- 
dition that  a  vicarage  should  be  endowed ; 
and  this  was  left  to  the  care  of  the  bishop. 
But  whenever  the  vicar  had  a  competent 
subsistence  by  endowment,  the  monks  took 
all  opportunities  to  lessen  it ;  and  this 
occasioned  several  decretals  prohibiting 
such  usage  without  the  bishop's  consent, 
and  that  no  custom  should  be  pleaded  for  it, 
where  he  that  served  the  cure  had  not  a 
competent  subsistence.  And  it  has  been  a 
question  whether  an  appropriation  is  good 
when  there  is  no  endowment  of  a  vicarage, 
because  the  statute  of  Henry  IV.  positively 
provides  that  vicarages  shall  be  endowed. 
But  it  is  now  settled,  that  if  it  is  a  vicarage 
in  reputation,  and  vicars  have  been  insti- 
tuted and  inducted  to  the  church,  it  shall  be 
presumed  that  the  vicarage  was  originally 
endowed.  Thus  much  for  the  tithes  :  but 
the  abbot  and  convent  had  not  only  the 
tithes  of  the  appropriate  churches,  but  the 
right  of  patronage  too ;  for  that  was  ex- 
tinct, as  to  the  former  patron,  by  the  ap- 
propriation, unless  he  had  reserved  the 
presentation  to  himself ;  and  that  made  the 
advowson  disappropriate,  and  the  church 
jjresentable  as  before,  but  not  by  the  old 
patron,  but  by  the  abbot  and  convent,  who 
were  then  bound,  upon  a  vacancy,  to  p)re- 
sent  a  person  to  the  bishop.  Sometimes 
the  bishop  would  refuse  the  person  pre- 
sented unless  they  consented  to  such  an 
allowance  for  his  maintenance  as  he  thought 
fit,  and  therefore  they  would  present  none. 
This  occasioned  the  making  another  decretal, 
which  gave  the  bishop  power  to  present ; 
but  this  did  not  often  happen,  because  the 
monks  were  favoured  by  the  bishops  ;  that 
is,  the  poorer  sort,  for  the  rich  would  not 
accept  his  kindness.  They  always  got 
their  appropriations  confirmed  by  the  pope, 
and  their  churches  exempted  from  the 
jurisdiction  of  the  bishop.  But  all  those 
exemptions  were  taken  away  by  the  statute 
31  Henry  VIII.  cap.  13,  and  the  ordinary- 
was  restored  to  his  ancient  right. 

APSE,  or  APSIS.  A  semicircular  or 
polygonal  termination  of  the  choir,  or  other 
portion  of  a  church.  The  word  signified 
in  Greek  architecture  a  semi-dome,  or  a 
quarter  of  a  sphere,  over  a  half-cylindrical 
wall.  Literally  it  only  means  a  returned 
wall  of  any  shape,  as  in  astronomy  it 
means  the  returning  place  in  an  orbit.  It 
was  called  in  Latin  testudo  or  concha,  from. 

E  2 


52 


APSE 


the  same  reason  that  a  liemisplierical  recess 
in    the    school-room  at   "Westminster   was 
called  the  shell.     The  ancient  Basilicas,  as 
may  still  he  seen  at  Rome,  had  universally 
a  semicircular  apse,  round  which  the  su- 
perior clergy  had  their  seats  ;  at  the  upper 
end  was  the  bishop's  throne ;  the  altar  was 
placed  on  the  chord  of  the  arc ;  the  tran- 
sept, or  gallery,  intervened  between  the  apse 
or  the  choir.     There  the    inferior  clergy, 
singers,  &c.,  were  stationed,  and  there  the 
lessons  were  read  from  the  ambon.     (See 
Clioir  and  Chant.)     This  form  was  gene- 
rally observed,  at  least   in  large  churches, 
for  many  ages,  of  which  Germany  affords 
frequent  specimens.    And  as  Mr.  Neale  has 
shown  in  his  very  valuable  remarks  on  the 
Eastern  Churches  (^Hist.  of  the  Holy  Oreeh 
Church),  the  apse  is  the  almost  invariable 
form  eveu  in  parish  churches  in  the  East. 
Of  this  arrangement  there   are   traces   in 
England.    Then  large  Saxon  churches,  as 
we  collect  from  history,  generally  had  an 
eastern  apse   at    least,  and  often    several 
others.    In  Norman  churches  of  large  size, 
the  apse  was  very  frequent,   and  it  was 
repeated  in  several  parts  of   the   church. 
These  inferior  apses  represented  the  oriental 
exedrse,    which     usually     terminate     their 
sacristies.      Norwich     and     Peterborough 
cathedrals  convey  a  good  impression  of  the 
general   character  of  Norman   churches  in 
this  respect.     Traces  of  the  apse  are  found 
also  at  Winchester,  Rochester,  Ely,  Lincoln, 
St.  Alban's,  Ripon,  Gloucester,  and  Worcester 
cathedrals,  besides  Malvern,  Tewkesbury,  and 
other  conventual  churches,  and  it  is  known 
to  have  existed  in  others  where  no  actual 
traces  remain  now.     At  St.  Alban's  there 
were  seven ;  for  the  transepts  had  each  two 
apsidal  chapels,  besides  those  of  the  aisles 
and  the  choir.     At   Canterbury   the  apse 
seems  to   have    been    disturbed    by    sub- 
sequent arrangements.     But  it  is  remark- 
able  that   the  ancient  archiepiscopal  chair 
stood  behind  the  altar  in  a  sort  of  apse  till 
late  in  the  last  century.     And  the  bishop 
or  priest  sometimes  celebrated  mass  stand- 
ing there,  "  before  the  altar  "  in  the  opposite 
sense  to  what  we  understand  now.     (Ven- 
ables'  Essay  on  Cathedrals.)     Traces  of  the 
ancient    apse  at  Chester    have    been  dis- 
covered of  late  years.     In  small  churches, 
as  Steetley,  Derl3yshire,  and  Birkin,  York- 
shire, the  eastern  apse  alone  is  found,  nor 
is  this  at  all  an  universal  feature.     See  Mr. 
Hussey's   Notice   of    recent    discoveries   in 
Chester  Cathedral.     There   are  three  very 
interesting  English  specimens  in  Hereford- 
shire, viz.  as  at  Kilpech,  Mocoas,  and  Peter 
Church ;  all  small  parish  churches,  and  of 
Norman  date;    and  with   regular  chancel 
below  the  apse.     In  the  early  British  and 
Irish  churches  there  is  no  trace  of  an  apse. 


AQUARn 

even  in  those  which  the  learned  Dr.  Petrie, 
in  his  essay  on  round  towers,  attributes  to 
the  fifth  and  sixth  centuries.  "With  the  post- 
Norman  styles  the  apse  was  almost  wholly 
discontinued,  though  an  Early  English  apse 
occurs    at     Tidmarsh,    Berkshire,    and    a 
Decorated  apse  at  Little   Maplestead;  the 
latter    is,    however,   altogether  an    excep- 
tional case.      There    seems  to  have  been 
some  tendency  to  reproduce  the  apse  in  the 
fifteenth    century,   as    at    Trinity   church, 
Coventry,  and  Henry  VII.'s  chapel,  and  the 
choir  of  Westminster;  but  the  latter  examples 
are  all  polygonal  instead  of  semicircular,  and 
generally  miss  the  grandeur  of  the  Norman 
apse.     The  polygonal  apse,  however,  of  the 
Lady  Chapel  at  Lichfield,  erected  about  1310, 
is  dignified  as  well  as  graceful.  And  the  later 
styles  have  one  great  advantage  in  the  treat- 
ment of  this  feature  in  their  flying  buttresses 
spanning  the  outer  aisle  of  the  apse,  which 
is  often   so   striking  a  feature  in  foreign 
churches,  and  to   which  the  perpendicular 
clerestory  to  the  Norman  apse  of  Norwich 
makes   some    approach.      In    the    modem 
church    of   St.    Chad's    Headingley,    near 
Leeds,  an  apsidal  aisle  or  "  periapse  "  is  thus 
curved  round  the  main  one,  with  excellent 
architectural  effect  and  very  usefuL     Some 
writers  have  confounded  the  apse  with  the 
choir  or  chancel ;  and  think  that,  according 
to    primitive  usage,   the  holy  table  ought 
to  stand  between  the  latter  and  the  nave  : 
whereas  in  fact  it  always  stood  above  the 
choir ;  so  that  in  churches  where  there  is 
no  apse  (and  none  was  required  when  there 
were  no  collegiate  or  capitular  clergy)  its 
proper  place  is  close  to  the  eastern  wall  of 
the  church.     (See  Cathedral.) 

AQUARII.  A  sect  of  heretics,  who,  in 
the  Primitive  times,  consecrated  water  at 
the  Holy  Eucharist,  instead  of  wine.  Still 
they  did  it  under  the  delusion  that  it  was  uni- 
versally unlawful  to  drink  wine ;  although, 
as  St.  Chrysostom  says,  our  blessed  Lord 
instituted  the  Holy  Eucharist  in  wine,  and 
himself  drank  wine  at  his  communion  table, 
and  after  his  resurrection,  as  if  by  anticipa- 
tion to  condemn  this  pernicious  heresy.  It 
is  lamentable  to  see  so  bold  an  impiety  re- 
vived in  the  present  day,  when  certain  men, 
under  the  cloak  of  temperance,  pretend  a 
Eucharist  without  wine,  or  any  fermented 
liquor.  These  are  not  to  be  confounded  with 
another  sect,  who  allowed  the  use  of  wine, 
but  in  their  morning  assemblies  used  water, 
for  fear  the  smell  of  wine  should  discover 
them  to  the  heathen.  It  was  very  wrong 
and  unworthy  of  the  Christian  name,  but  far 
less  culpable  than  the  pretence  of  a  temper- 
ance above  that  of  Christ  and  the  Church,  in 
which  the  Aquarii  boasted.  St.  Cyprian, 
giving  an  account  of  these,  tells  us  that  it  was 
the  custom  of  the  Church  to  use  watermixed 


AEABICS 

■with  wine.  (See  Mixed  Chalice.) — Epiph. 
Uaires.  xlvi. ;  August,  de  Hxres.  o.  46 ; 
Cyprian,  Ep.  Ixiii.  ad  Oscilium. ;  Bingham, 
Antiq.  Chr.  Ch.  bk.  xv.  c.  2,  §  7;  New- 
man's Pleury,  xxiv.  55. 

ARABICS,  ARABICI,  or  ARABIANS. 
Heretics  who  appeared  in  Arabia  in  the 
third  century.  According  to  Eusebius, 
they  taught  that  the  soul  died,  and  was 
corrupted  with  the  body,  and  that  they 
were  to  be  raised  together  at  the  last  day. 
— ^Euseb.  Hist.  Eccl.  Lit.  vi.  c.  26. 

ARCADE.  In  church  architecture,  a 
series  of  arches  supported  by  pUlars  or 
shafts,  whether  belonging  to  the  construc- 
tion, or  used  in  relieving  large  surfaces  of 
masonry:  the  present  observations  will  be 
confined  to  the  latter,  that  is,  to  ornamental 
arcades. 

These  were  introduced  early  in  the  Nor- 
man style,  and  were  used  very  largely  to 
its  close,  the  whole  base  story  of  exterior 
and  interior  alike,  and  the  upper  portions  of 
towers  and  of  high  walls  being  often  quite 
covered  with  them.  They  were  either  of 
simple  or  of  intersecting  arches :  it  is  need- 
less to  say  that  the  latter  are  the  most 
elaborate  in  work,  and  the  most  ornamental ; 
they  are  accordingly  reserved  in  general  for 
the  richer  portions  of  the  fabric.  There  is, 
moreover,  another,  and  perhaps  even  more 
effective,  way  of  complicating  the  arcade, 
by  placing  an  arcade  within  and  behind 
another,  so  that  the  wall  is  doubly  recessed, 
and  the  play  of  light  and  shadow  greatly 
increased.  The  decorations  of  the  Tran- 
sitional, until  very  late  in  the  style,  are  so 
nearly  those  of  the  Norman,  that  we  need 
not  particularise  the  semi-Norman  arcade. 
In  the  next  style  the  simple  arcade  is  the 
most  frequent.  This,  like  the  Norman,  often 
covers  large  surfaces.  Foiled  or  cusped 
arches  are  often  introduced  at  this  period 
and  greatly  vary  the  effect.  The  duplica- 
tion of  arcades  is  now  managed  differently 
from  the  former  style.  Two  arcades,  perfect 
in  all  their  parts,  are  set  the  one  behind  the 
other,  but  the  shaft  of  the  outer  is  opposite 
to  the  arch  of  the  inner  series,  the  outer 
series  is  also  more  lofty  in  its  proportions, 
and  the  two  are  often  of  differently  con- 
structed arches,  as  at  Beverley  and  Lincoln, 
where  the  outer  series  is  of  trefoil,  the  inner 
of  simple  arches,  or  vice  versa,  the  two 
always  being  different.  The  effect  of  this 
is  extremely  beautiful. 

But  the  most  exqmsite  arcades  are  those 
of  the  Geometrical  period,  where  each  arch 
is  often  surmounted  by  a  crocketted  pedi- 
ment, and  the  higher  efforts  of  sculpture  are 
tasked  for  their  enrichment,  as  in  the  glorious 
chapter-house  of  Salisbury,  Southwell,  and 
above  all  York ;  these  are,  however,  usually 
confined  to  the  interior.     In  the  Decorated 


ARCHBISHOP 


53 


period  partially,  and  in  the  Perj)endioular 
entirely,  the  arcade  gave  place  to  panelling, 
greatly  to  the  loss  of  effect,  for  no  delicacy 
or  intricacy  of  pattern  can  compensate  for 
the  bright  light  and  deep  shadows  of  the 
Noi-man  and  Early  English  arcades.  There 
are  so  many  varieties,  both  in  form  and  size, 
that  we  must  refer  to  architectural  books  for 
other  examples. 

ARCANI  DISCIPLINA.  The  name 
given  to  a  part  of  the  discipline  of  the  early 
Church  in  withdrawing  from  public  view 
the  sacraments  and  higher  mysteries  of  our 
religion :  a  practice  founded  on  a  reverence 
for  the  sacred  mysteries  themselves,  and  to 
prevent  their  being  exposed  to  the  ridicule 
of  the  heathen.  Irenajus,  Tertullian,  and 
Clement  of  Alexandria  are  the  first  who 
mention  any  such  custom  in  the  Church. 
This  secrecy,  however  wise  at  the  time,  had 
the  effect  of  aggravating  the  hostility  of  the 
heathen,  as  they  could  assert  that  as  the 
Christian  rites  were  carried  on  thus  privately, 
there  must  be  something  in  them  contrary 
to  the  law  of  common  morality.  The  Disci- 
plina  Arcani  gradually  fell  into  disuse  after 
the  time  of  Constantino,  when  Christianity 
had  nothing  to  fear  from  its  enemies. — 
Bingham,  Antiq.  x.  v. ;  Freeman's  Princ. 
Div.  Serv.  ii.  386. 

ARCH.  AH  architecture  may  be  divided 
into  the  architecture  of  the  entablature 
and  of  the  arch.  The  subject  is  much  too 
large  to  discuss  here,  and  we  must  refer  to 
architectural  books  for  a  multitude  of  ex- 
amples of  all  kinds  of  arches,  round,  pointed, 
cusped,  moulded,  ogee,  four-centred,  stUted, 
elliptic,  segmental,  equilateral,  &c. 

ARCHBISHOP.  (See  also  Metropolitan ; 
Patriarch ;  Primate.)  The  head  of  the  hie- 
rarchy in  a  whole  province,  who  has  the  over- 
sight of  the  bishops  as  well  as  of  the  inferior 
clergy  in  that  province. 

I.  General  history.  According  to  Beve- 
ridge.  Cod.  Can.  Vindicat.  ii.,  c.  v.,  s.  12, 
Hammond,  Prxfat.  ad  Titum,'Ush.eT,de  Grig. 
Episcop.  et  Metropolit.,  and  others,  the  office, 
though  not  the  title,  was  of  apostolical 
institution.  This  view  is  founded  mainly  on 
the  fact  that  the  Apostles  commonly  made 
the  chief  city  in  each  province  the  starting 
point  and  centre  of  their  missionary  work, 
and  that  St.  Paul,  in  his  epistles,  sometimes 
addresses  the  faithful  in  each  province  as 
forming  one  community — e.g.  "  the  Church 
of  God  which  is  at  Corinth,  with  all  the  saints 
which  are  in  all  Achaia  "  (2  Cor.  i.  1),  and 
"  wito  the  Churches  of  Galatia "  (Gal.  i.  2). 
It  is  obvious  that  a  Church  once  established 
in  the  chief  city  of  a  province  would  be  likely 
to  rank  above  the  other  Churches.  And,  in 
many  cases,  this  pre-eminence  would  be  two- 
fold, depending  partly  on  the  civil  importance 
of  the  capital,  partly  on  the  fact  that  the 


54 


AECHBISHOP 


Church  there  was  the  earliest,  and  so  was 
looked  upon  as  the  mother-Church  of  all  the 
rest  in  that  district. 

The  4th  Canon  of  the  Council  of  Nic^a 
clearly  accepts  the  civil  division  as  the 
basis  of  the  ecclesiastical,  for  it  decrees  that 
bishops  shall  be  appointed  by  all  the  bishops 
in  the  province,  and  that  the  right  of  con- 
firmatiou  belongs  to  the  metropolitan  in  each 
province.  And  the  6th  Canon  declares  that 
if  any  one  was  made  bishop  without  the 
consent  of  the  metropolitan,  the  appointment 
ought  to  be  held  invalid.  Epiphanius, 
writing  in  A.D.  376  (^Hseres.  Ixviii.,  n.  1),  says 
that  it  was  the  custom  for  the  Archhishop 
in  Alexandria  to  have  the  ecclesiastical 
administration  of  all  Egypt,  Libya,  the 
Thebaid,  &c.  And  similar  metropolitical 
rights  are  stated  in  the  6th  Canon  of  Nica;a 
to  pertain  to  the  sees  of  Antioch,  Eome,  and 
other  capitals  of  provinces  hy  ancient  custom 
(to.  ap)((iia  (dr)  KpaTeirai).  When  Constantine 
made  a  new  partition  of  the  empire  into 
dioceses,  each  of  which  comprised  several 
provinces,,  an  arrangement  nearly  analogous 
followed  in  the  Church.  The  bishop  of  the 
capital  city  in  each  province  was  designated 
Metropolitan  or  Archbishop,  while  the  bishop 
of  the  chief  city  in  the  diocese  ranked  above 
the  other  metropolitans,  and  had  the  title 
in  the  East  sometimes  of  Exarch,  in  the 
"West,  of  Primate,  but  the  most  eminent  were 
afterwards  commonly  called  Patriarchs,  a 
name  originally  applied  to  any  bishop.  The 
first  express  mention  of  this  title  in  the  more 
restricted  sense  is  at  the  Council  of  Chalcedon 
in  451,  when  the  see  of  Jerusalem  was  made 
patriarchal,  in  addition  to  those  of  Eome, 
Constantinople,  Alexandria,  and  Antioch, 
which  already  enjoyed  that  dignity.  This, 
however,  was  on  account  of  its  pre-eminent 
sanctity,  for  Cajsarea,  and  not  Jerusalem, 
was  the  capital  of  the  province. — Eobert- 
son.  Hist.  i.  313,  461,  475;  Suioer,  sub  v. 
StoUrjo-is ;  Bingham,  ii.  17,  s.  8. 

II.  In  Britain.  There  is  no  evidence  of 
the  existence  of  archbishoprics  in  the  early 
British  Church.  We  may  presume  that  the 
three  bishoi^s  who  attended  the  Council  of 
Aries  in  314,  Eburius  of  York,  Eestitutus  of 
London,  and  Adelphius,  whose  see  has  not 
been  identified,  but  was  probably  Caerleon 
(Haddan  and  Stubbs,  i.  7),  were  the  most 
eminent  in  the  island,  but  they  are  not 
styled  archbishops.  At  the  time  of  Augus- 
tine's mission  to  England  in  597,  London 
and  York  were  no  doubt  considered  the  most 
important  cities  in  the  south  and  north,  and 
it  is  evident,  from  a  letter  written  to  Augus- 
tine in  601  by  Gregory  the  Great  (Bede,  i.  29, 
and  Ep.  ad  Ecgbertum,  s.  5),  that  the  latter 
thought  the  jjrincipal  sees  should,  as  in  the 
Eoman  Empire,  be  planted  in  the  principal 
cities,  a:.d  that  the  dioceses  should  be  framed 


AECHBISHOP 

upon  the  lines  of  some  existing  civil  divisions. 
There  were  to  be  twelve  dioceses  in  the  south, 
over  which  the  Bishop  of  London  was  to 
preside  as  archbishop,  and  to  be  always 
consecrated  by  his  own  synod  of  suffragans. 
Augustine  was  to  consecrate  a  bishop  for 
York,  who,  in  his  turn,  was  to  consecrate 
twelve  suffragans,  and  be  their  archbishop ; 
but  Augustine  was,  during  his  life,  to  be 
supreme  over  the  northern  metropolitan. 
This  scheme,  however,  was  defeated  by  the 
course  of  events.  London  did  not  become 
Christian  for  many  years  after  the  coming, 
of  Augustine,  and  the  see  originally  estab- 
lished at  Canterbury  by  King  Ethelberht 
and  Augustine  has  always  retained  its 
metropolitan  rank.  The  see  of  York  was 
founded  in  625,  but  it  was  not  made  archie- 
piscopal  till  735,  when  the  Northumbrian 
kingdom  was  in  a  condition  of  remarkable 
prosperity  and  independence.  (Bede,  Ep.  ad 
Ecgb.,  s.  5,  Sax.  Chron.) 

During  a  brief  supremacy  of  the  Mercian 
kingdom,  Offa  made  the  see  of  Lichfield  an 
archbishopric,  but  it  only  lasted  from  787 
to  803.  Down  to  the  time  of  the  Norman 
Conquest,  the  Archbishops  of  York  acquiesced 
in  the  supremacy  of  the  see  of  Canterbury,- 
but  after  that  event  it  was  frequently 
disputed.  At  the  consecration  of  Anselm  in 
1093,  Thomas  of  York  objected  to  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury  being  styled  "  Metro-' 
politan  of  Great  Britain,"  and  it  was  then 
decided  that  the  Archbishop  of  York  should 
be  called  "  Primate  of  England  and  Metro- 
politan," the  Archbishop  of  Canterbury 
"  Primate  of  all  England  and  Metropolitan." 
The  contest,  however,  did  not  end  here.  In 
1119,  Thurstan,  Archbishop  elect  of  York, 
refused  to  make  profession  of  obedience  at 
his  consecration  to  the  Archbishop  of 
Canterbury,  and  was  consecrated  by  the 
pope  instead.  The  struggle  for  precedence, 
which  was  carried  on  at  intervals  during  the 
12th,  13th,  and  part  of  the  14th  centuries, 
turned  mainly  on  this  question  of  profession  of 
obedience,  on  the  position  which  each  arch- 
bishop was  to  occupy  at  national  ceremonials,, 
and  on  the  right  of  the  Archbishop  of  York 
to  have  his  cross  carried  before  him  within 
the  province  of  Canterbury.  These  questions- 
were  finally  settled  in  1353,  during  the- 
pontificates  of  Simon  Islip  of  Canterbury, 
and  John  Thoresby  of  York,  when,  on  all 
essential  points,  precedence  was  secured  for 
the  see  of  Canterbury. — ^Hook,  Archhishops, 
ii.  157, 195,  288,  416 ;  iv.  122-124. 

Both  archbishops  have  the  title  of 
"  Grace  "  and  "  Most  reverend  father  in  God 
by  divine  Providence  " :  but  the  Archbishop 
of  Canterbury  ranks  as  the  first  peer  in  the 
realm  after  dukes  of  royal  blood,  the  Lord 
Chancellor  ranks  second,  and  the  Archbishop- 
of  York  third.     The  Archbishop  of  Canter- 


AKCHBISHOP 

iDury  has  the  right  of  crowning  the  sovereign 
and  of  granting  certain  dispensations  to  hold 
two  livings,  to  he  ordained  before  the 
statutable  and  canonical  age,  to  be  married 
anywhere  and  at  any  hour,  by  special  licence. 
These  are  relics  of  the  pope's  dispensing 
jMwer,  which  was  transferred  to  the  arch- 
bishop when  not  contrary  to  God's  word,  by 
25  Henry  VIII.  c.  31. 

Method  of  Electing.  (1)  In  the  early 
Church  the  election  of  archbishops  was  made 
by  the  bishops  of  the  province,  subject  to 
the  consent  of  the  clergy  and  laity.  (Bing- 
ham, ii.,  c.  xvi.,  s.  15).  When  the  kingdoms 
which  grew  out  of  the  ruins  of  the  Western 
Empire  were  converted  to  Christianity,  their 
sovereigns  naturally  exercised  much  in- 
fluence upon  the  election,  and  the  popes 
early  acquired  the  right  of  confirmation. 
From  the  sixth  century  it  became  a  custom 
(which  was  formally  ratified  in  742  by  the 
Synod  of  FranMurt)  for  all  metropolitans  to 
obtain  a  vestment  from  the  pope  called  the 
"pallium,"  without  which  they  were  not 
qualified  to  consecrate  bishops;  and  when 
they  received  it,  they  made  a  kind  of  pro- 
fession of  obedience  to  the  pope. 

(2)  In  England,  prior  to  the  Norman 
Conquest,  the  archbishops,  like  the  bishops, 
were  commonly  appointed  by  the  king  and 
the  Witan  in  the  great  national  Gemotes. 
After  the  Conquest,  and  prior  to  the  Refor- 
mation, the  appointments  to  the  see  of 
Canterbury  were  the  results  sometimes  of  a 
concurrence,  more  often  of  a  conflict  between 
several  parties,  who  all  claimed  to  have  some 
voice  in  the  election — the  king,  who  nomi- 
nated or  recommended,  the  suflFragan  bishops, 
who  approved,  the  Chapter  of  Canterbury, 
who  elected,  the  pope  who  confirmed.  The 
popes,  however,  in  various  ways  acquired  an 
increasing  power  over  the  appointments.  In 
cases  of  disputed  election,  appeal  was  made 
to  them,  and  Innocent  III.  laid  down  the  rule 
that  if  the  electors  had  chosen  an  unworthy 
person,  the  appointment  lapsed  to  the  pope. 
He  also  rejected  the  claim  of  the  bishops  to 
take  part  in  the  elections,  and  it  was  never 
raised  again.  Stephen  Langton  was  pressed 
into  the  see  by  the  sole  authority  of  the 
pope,  and,  after  this,  the  king  and  the  pope 
often  conspired  to  defeat  the  election  of  the 
Chapter.  The  appointment  of  Robert 
Winchelsey  in  1294  was  one  of  the  rare 
cases  in  which  all  the  electing  parties  agreed. 
— Stubbs,  Const.  Hist.  iiL  305,  306;  Wil- 
kins,  Cone.  ii.  197. 

Besides  giving  the  pallium,  the  pope 
bestowed  the  legatine  commission  on  the 
archbishops  in  England.  A  prescriptive 
right  to  it  was  asserted  for  the  see  by 
Ansebn,  and  finally  acknowledged  in  the 
time  of  Stephen  Langton,  1291.  Legates  "a 
latere"  were  admitted  for  special  purposes,  but 


AKCHBISHOP 


55 


the  archbishops  of  Canterbury  were  regarded 
as  "  legati  nati,"  who  had  an  exclusive  right 
to  a  permanent  commission.  The  effect  of 
this  was  to  enhance  the  Papal  power  by 
giving  to  the  archbishop's  jurisdiction  the 
colour  of  delegated  authority  from  Rome. 
The  archbishops  of  York  had  the  pallium 
and  (from  about  the  year  1350)  the  legatine 
commission  also.  During  the  vacancy  of 
any  see  in  his  province,  the  archbishop  is 
guardian  of  the  spiritualities,  as  the  king  is 
of  the  temporalities,  and  during  such 
vacancy  all  episcopal  rights  belong  to  him  ; 
but  the  visitatorial  power  over  Isuffragans 
has  not  been  exercised  since  the  time  of 
Archbishop  Laud. 

Some  of  the  Archbishop  of  Canterbury's 
suffragans  rank  as  his  officials  under  various 
titles.  The  Bishop  of  London  is  his  dean, 
the  Bishop  of  Winchester  his  chancellor,  the 
Bishop  of  Salisbmy  his  precentor,  the  Bishop 
of  Worcester  his  chaplain,  the  Bishop  of 
Rochester  his  crosier-bearer,  the  Bishop  of 
Lincoln  his  vice-chancellor.  The  suffragans 
of  the  province  of  Canterbury  are  now  22 — 
London,  Winchester,  Bangor,  Bath  and 
Wells,  Chichester,  Ely,  Exeter,  Gloucester 
and  Bristol,  Hereford,  Lichfield,  Lincoln, 
Llandaff,  Norwich,  Oxford,  Peterboro',  St. 
Alban's  (founded  in  1877),  St.  Asaph,  St, 
David's,  Salisbury,  Southwell  (founded 
1884),  Truro  (founded  1879),  Worcester. 
The  Archbishop  of  York  has  eight  suffragans 
— Durham  (who  ranks  between  London  and 
Winchester),  Carlisle,  Chester,  Liverpool 
(founded  1880),  Manchester  (founded  1848), 
Newcastle  (founded  1882),  Ripon  (founded 
1836),  Sodor  and  Man.  Wakefield  will 
make  a  ninth,  if  the  Act  of  1878  is  carried 
into  effect,  which  authorised  the  foundation 
of  sees  in  Liverpool,  Newcastle,  Southwell, 
and  Wakefield,  whenever  an  endowment  of 
£3000  a  year  is  provided  for  them,  or  £2500 
with  a  house  of  the  value  of  £500  a  year. 

The  term  suffragan  is  also  applied  to  any 
bishop  appointed  to  assist  another.  Under 
the  Act  of  26  Henry  YIII.,  there  are  now 
four  such  in  England — Dover,  Nottingham, 
Bedford,  and  Colchester.     (See  Suffragan.) 

Jurisdiction  of  the  Archbishops.  (1)  In 
province  of  Canterbury.  From  the  Norman 
Conquest  to  the  Reformation  there  were 
four  courts. 

(a)  The  Court  of  the  Arches  (because  held 
in  Bow  Church,  Sancta  Maria  de  Arcubus), 
presided  over  by  the  archbishop's  "  official 
principal,"  was  the  court  of  appeal  from  all 
the  diocesan  courts  of  the  province,  and 
also  a  court  of  first  instance  in  all  ecclesi- 
astical cases.  The  "  official  principal "  was 
the  representative  of  the  archbishop  in  his 
judicial  capacity  as  completely  as  the  "  chief 
justice  "  was  the  representative  of  the  king. 

(b)  The  Court  of  Audience,  in  which  the 


56 


ARCHDEACON 


archbishop  himself  tried  cases  reserved  for 
his  own  personal  hearing. 

(c)  The  Prerogative  Court,  in  which  the 
testamentary  jurisdiction  was  transacted 
under  a  judge  called  Master-keeper,  or 
Commissary. 

(d)  The  Com-t  of  Peculiars,  held  in  Bow 
Church,  adjudicated  on  causes  arising  within 
the  thirteen  London  parishes  which  were 
peculiars  of  the  archbishops.  The  Dean  of 
the  Arches  presided  in  this  court ;  he  was 
originally  distinct  from  and  subordinate  to 
the  official  principal,  but  ultimately  the  two 
offices  were  always  held  by  the  same  person. 

Cases  of  heresy  were  frequently  tried,  or 
at  least  investigated,  by  the  archbishop  in 
convocation. 

The  provincial  courts  of  the  Archbishop  of 
York  were  (i.)  the  Chancery  Court,  nearly 
equivalent  to  the  Canterbury  "Court  of 
Arches ;  (ii.)  the  Prerogative  Court.  From 
the  year  1559  to  1832  a  right  of  appeal  lay 
from  the  Archbishop's  Court  to  the  Court  of 
Delegates  created  by  the  statute  25  Henry 
Vni.  c.  19.  By  3  &  4  WiUiam  IV.  c.  41, 
the  appellate  jurisdiction  was  conferred  on 
the  Judicial  Committee  of  the  Privy  Council. 
— Report  of  Eoyal  Commission  on  Eccles. 
Courts,  and  Historical  Appendix. 

By  the  Public  Worship  Regulation  Act, 
37  &  38  Vict.  c.  85,  the  office  of  official 
principal,  both  of  Canterbury  and  York,  has 
been  transferred  to  a  judge  to  be  appointed 
by  the  archbishops,  subject  to  the  approval 
of  the  Crown. 

For  Archbishops  in  Ireland  and  Scotland, 
see  under  Cliurcli  in  Ireland,  Scotland,  &c. 
[W.  E.  W.  S.] 

AECHDEACON'.  'ApxihiaKovos,  'Apx'- 
8id(c(oj/,  'ApxiKeviTTjs,  in  Latin  sometimes 
Levita  Septimus.  (Johannes  Secundus  Vit. 
Oreg.  Max.  lib.  i.  c.  25.) 

Origin  and  development  of  the  office,  (i.) 
in  the  Church  at  large ;  (ii.)  in  the  Church 
of  Kngland. 

(i.)  It  is  very  probable  that  there  was 
even  in  apostolic  times  a  primacy  amongst 
deacons,  but  upon  what  it  depended, 
whether  upon  seniority  or  ability,  and 
whether  it  was  part  of  a  fixed  system,  there 
is  really  no  evidence  to  determine.  St. 
Lawrence  (who  died  a.d.  260)  is  called  Arch- 
deacon by  St.  Augustine,  Serm.  de  Di- 
versis,  cxi.  c.  9,  and  so  is  St.  Caacilian  of 
Carthage  by  Optatus  (Lib.  i.  p.  18,  ed.  Paris, 
1679),  but  some  lines  in  Prudentius  (Perist. 
Hymn.  II.)  would  seem  to  indicate  that  the 
former  was  only  the  principal  of  seven 
deacons  who  served  at  the  altar. 

"  Hie  primus  e  septem  viris 
Qui  stant  ad  aram  proximi, 
Levita  sublitnis  gradu." 

In  the  Eastern  Church  the  office  does  not 


AECHDEACON 

distinctly  appear  before  the  end  of  the 
fourth  or  beginning  of  the  fifth  century. 
Serapion,  who  helped  to  make  St.  John  Chry- 
sostom  unpopular  by  advising  him  to  rule 
his  clergy  with  more  severity  (Socr.  vi.  4), 
is  called  his  archdeacon  (Sozomen,  viii.  9). 
John  of  Antioch  dealt  with  the  envoys  of 
the  Council  of  Ephesus,  431,  through  his 
archdeacon  (ATansi,  iv.  1223),  and  St. 
Athanasius  seems  to  have  held  a  like  confi- 
dential relation  towards  his  bishop  at 
Alexandria.  In  the  East,  however,  the 
office  never  became  very  prominent,  nor 
were  its  duties  very  clearly  defined. 

In  the  Western  Chiurch,  on  the  other 
hand,  where  the  office  appears  in  the  fourth 
century,  it  gradually  increases  in  impor- 
tance. Prom  a  letter  of  Jerome  (Ep.  ad 
Rusticum,  xov.)  we  learn  that  the  rule  was 
to  have  one  chief  presbyter,  and  one  chief 
deacon  in  each  diocese  ("  singuli  ecclesiarum 
episcopi,  singuli  archipresbyteri,  singuli 
archidjaooni "),  and  a  larger  number  was 
forbidden  by  the  Council  of  Merida  (Emerit) 
A.D.  666,  but  after  the  eighth  century  there 
was  commonly  more  than  one,  the  number 
varying  with  the  size  or  population  of  the 
diocese.  In  St.  Jerome's  time  an  arch- 
deacon thought  himself  injured  if  he  was 
ordained  a  presbyter  "injmiam  putat  si 
presbyter  ordinetur"  {Com.  in  Ezeh.  c.  48), 
iDut  after  the  9  th  century  the  custom  of  not 
raising  archdeacons  to  the  priesthood  began 
to  be  dropped.  The  functions  of  archdeacons 
were  gradually  developed  from  very  humble 
beginnings.  Out  of  the  simple  duty  of  dis- 
tributing the  alms  of  the  faithful  as  applied 
to  the  threefold  purposes  of  the  relief  of  the 
poor,  the  maintenance  of  the  clergy,  and  the 
repair  of  the  churches,  grew  the  right  of 
overseeing  the  general  condition  of  ecclesi- 
astical fabrics,  furniture,  and  ceremonial, 
the  morals,  the  manners,  the  dress  of  the 
clergy,  and  even  the  mode  of  cutting  their 
hau- ;  and  ascertaining  by  examination  or 
enquiry  the  qualification  of  candidates  for 
holy  orders.  Being  the  constant  companion 
of  the  bishop  (as  Jerome  expresses  it,  a 
pontificis  latere  non  recedit.  Com.  in  Ezek. 
c.  48),  not  only  at  celebrations  of  the  Holy 
Eucharist  (Ambrose,  de  Off.  lib.  i.  c.  41), 
when  it  was  his  duty  to  minister  the  cup 
after  the  bishop,  but  also  very  often  in  the 
capacity  of  private  chaplain  or  secretary,  he 
became  intimately  acquainted  with  the 
bishop's  mind,  whence  he  was  called  "cor 
episcopi,"  the  "bishop's  heart";  and  his 
principal  agent  in  the  oversight  of  the 
diocese,  whence  his  appellation,  "oculus 
episcopi,"  the  bishop's  eye  {Apost.  Const. 
ii.  44 ;  Bingham,  ii.  c.  xx.  §  18).  And  so 
Isidore  of  Pelusium,  Ep.  i.  29,  tells  his 
archdeacon  that  he  ought  to  be  "  all  eye," 
"  okos  6(f>6dKfi6s  d(j)eCX(is  vndpx^iv," 


AKCHDEACON 

Before  the  end  of  the  ninth  century  it  is 
certain  that  the  archdeacons  were  occasion- 
ally at  least  deputed  by  the  bishop  to  hold 
visitations,  and  exercise  some  kind  of  juris- 
diction over  the  clergy;  for  in  a.d.  874, 
Hinomar,  Archbishop  of  Eeims,  addressed 
a  letter  to  his  archdeacons,  Gunthar  and 
Odelhard,  instructing  them  how  to  act  when 
they  were  making  their  visitations  (Mansi, 
XV.  497).  And  the  Council  of  Chalons  in  813 
censured  the  custom  of  exacting  fees  for 
archidiaconal  visitations. 

Prom  the  tenth  century  onward  the 
archdeacons,  as  a  rule,  obtained  a  delegatio 
perpetua,  which  made  them  irremovable, 
and  gave  them  a  formidable  power  of  juris- 
diction, sometimes  almost  co-ordinate  with 
that  of  the  bishop  himself. 

(ii.)  In  the  Church  of  England  the  earliest 
direct  notice  of  archdeacons  occurs  in  the 
Pontifical  of  Ecgbert,  Archbishop  of  York 
(a.d.  735-766),  where  they  are  described 
as  assisting  at  ordination,  and  allusions  are 
made  to  them  in  some  of  Alcuin's  letters, 
but  there  do  not  seem  to  have  been  any 
territorial  archdeaconries  in  the  Northern 
Province  till  after  the  Norman  Conquest, 
when  Archbishop  Thomas  divided  the  dio- 
cese into  five.  And  in  the  Province  of 
Canterbury,  although  we  find  the  signature 
of  an  Archdeacon  Wulfred  to  a  statute  of 
Archbishop  .^thelhard  in  a.d.  803,  Lan- 
franc  was  the  first  to  invest  the  archdeacons 
■jvith  powers  of  jurisdiction  in  accordance 
•with  the  edict  of  the  Conqueror,  separating 
the  civil  and  ecclesiastical  courts.  The 
large  amount  of  secular  business  in  wliich 
the  bishops  were  involved  after  the  Con- 
quest, partly  as  great  landowners,  partly  as 
state  ofiicials,  leading  to  frequent  and  pro- 
tracted absence  from  their  dioceses,  threw 
an  increasing  quantity  of  so-called  spiritual 
business  upon  the  archidiaconal  courts. 
These  courts,  wliich  were  originally  execu- 
tive departments  merely  under  the  bishop, 
had  generally  acquired  a  customary  juris- 
diction before  the  middle  of  the  twelfth 
century;  and  by  the  Constitutions  of 
Clarendon,  1164,  appeals  lay  from  the  arch- 
deacon's court  to  the  bishop's.  This  increase 
in  the  archdeacon's  independent  power  was 
a  subject  of  alarm  to  the  bishops,  and  at- 
tempts were  commonly  made  in  the  twelfth 
century  to  check  it  by  the  creation  of  the 
office  of  "  official,"  to  act  as  judge  ordinary 
in  all  cases  pertaining  to  the  bishop's  juris- 
diction. But  the  check  seems  to  have  been 
of  little  avail,  and  a  large  amount  of  business 
continued  to  be  swept  into  the  archidiaconal 
courts.  They  were  very  unpopular  both 
with  the  clergy  and  laity,  partly  on  account 
of  the  petty  and  vexatious  nature  of  the 
suits  which  were  brought  into  them,  and 
partly  owing  to  the  exorbitant  fees  which 


ARCHDEACON 


57 


were  exacted  by  the  officials.  The  inquisi- 
torial character,  too,  of  the  archdeacon's 
visitations,  and  the  insolence  of  the  numerous 
apparitors  and  grooms  who  formed  his 
retinue,  were  a  continual  source  of  com- 
plaint. Archbishop  Stratford,  in  1343,  en- 
deavoured to  redi-ess  these  grievances  by 
various  regulations  (Hook,  Archhisliops,  iv. 
64-66),  but  probably  with  little  success ;  for 
the  common  feeling  respecting  them  fifty 
years  later  is  reflected  in  some  very  uncom- 
plimentary lines  in  Chaucer  {Prologue  to 
Canterbury  Talcs,  and  the  Friar's  Tale). 
See  Hook,  Archhishops,  iii.  39,  40. 

The  archidiaconal  courts  sm-vived  the 
Reformation  in  England  in  the  sixteenth 
century,  being  recognised  by  the  statute  24 
Henry  VIII.  c.  12.  But  the  character  of  the 
business  transacted  in  them  was  necessarily 
in  many  respects  changed,  as  they  became 
instruments  for  suppressing  many  of  the 
opinions  and  practices  which  they  had  for- 
merly enforced.  Some  of  the  old  abuses,  how- 
ever, such  as  extortionate  fees  and  malicious 
infonnation,  still  clung  to  them,  and  against 
these  a  large  number  of  the  canons  of  1603 
are  directed.  Speaking  generally,  we  may 
say  that  during  the  sixteenth  and  seven- 
teenth centuries  the  courts  were  mainly 
concerned  with  the  registration  of  wills  and 
cases  which  arose  out  of  the  presentments 
made  by  churchwardens  and  other  witnesses 
on  oath  at  visitations,  embracing  a,  great 
variety  of  questions,  the  condition  of  the 
churches  and  their  furniture,  cases  of  slan- 
der, fornication,  brawling,  unlawful  labour 
or  sports  on  Sunday,  negligence  of  the 
clergy  in  discharge  of  their  duties,  or  of  the 
laity  in  attending  the  ordinances  of  religion. 
The  archdeacon  could  compel  church- 
wardens to  levy  rates  for  the  repair  of  the 
fabrics  or  the  purchase  of  the  needful  furni- 
tm-e  of  the  church,  they  could  enjoin  resti- 
tution or  penance  according  to  the  nature  of 
the  offence,  or  pronounce  excommunication, 
and  in  the  event  of  the  latter  being  disre- 
garded, could  call  in  the  aid  of  the  civil 
power. 

During  the  eighteenth  century,  the  busi- 
ness of  'the  archdeacon's  court  steadily 
diminished  from  a  variety  of  causes ;  some 
departments  of  it  became  transferred  to 
civil  courts;  others  were  rendered  inopera- 
tive by  Acts  of  Parliament.  And  to  these 
must  be  added  a  growing  indifference  to 
ecclesiastical  censures,  and  the  general 
religious  apathy  of  the  age  which  infected 
the  archdeacons  themselves,  as  well  as  those 
who  might  have  resorted  to  their  courts.  As 
the  power  to  do  very  much  declined,  the 
inclination  to  do  very  little  increased. 

The  revival  of  energy  in  the  Church 
during  the  last  fifty  years  has  infused  new 
life  into  the  office  of  archdeacons  as  weU  as 


58 


AKCHDEACON 


every  other  department.  Althougli  their 
powers  are  not  as  yet  legally  enlarged,  still 
their  definite  duties  are  not  few  or  insignifi- 
cant, and  the  influence  which  they  can 
exercise  in  various  indirect  ways  is  very 
considerable,  supposing,  of  course,  that  they 
are  men  of  abihty  and  force  of  character. 

Amongst  the  regular  duties  of  archdeacons 
may  he  specially  mentioned  examination  of 
candidates  for  Holy  Orders,  induction  of 
persons  instituted  to  benefices,  conducting 
the  election  of  proctors  for  the  clergy  in  Con- 
vocation, holding  annual  visitations  of  the 
clergy  and  churchwardens,  visiting  churches 
and  churchyards,  either  in  answer  to  an 
official  request,  or  periodically  with  a  view 
to  ascertaining  the  general  condition  of  the 
parishes,  and  composing  parochial  misunder- 
standings or  quarrels,  if  there  be  any.  If 
churchwardens  disregard  his  lawful  orders, 
the  archdeacon  can  "signify"  them  to  the 
Queen  in  Chancery  for  contempt  of  court, 
and  they  will  thereupon  be  imprisoned  until 
they  submit.  He  can  also  try  complaints 
against  parish  clerks  and  remove  them  from 
their  office,  if  proved  to  be  unfit  for  it  by 
reason  of  any  misconduct  (7  &  8  Vict.  c.  59). 
He  holds  commissions  under  the  Clergy 
Eesignation  Act,  and  of  inquiry  whether 
there  are  prima  facie  grounds  for  proceed- 
ings against  a  clergyman  whose  character  or 
conduct  has  been  impugned.  He  has,  if 
desired  by  the  bishop,  to  inquire  into  the 
boundaries  of  parishes  with  a  view  to  their 
readjustment,  to  preach  in  his  turn  in  the 
cathedral  if  he  is  a  canon,  and  to  attend  the 
sittings  of  Convocation.     [W.  R.  W.  S.] 

By  1  &  2  Vict.  c.  IOC,  s.  2,  an  arch- 
deacon may  hold  with  his  archdeaconry 
two  benefices  under  certain  restrictions :  or 
a  benefice  and  a  cathedral  preferment. 
But  these  restrictions  are  by  no  means 
clearly  expressed,  and  are  made  still  more 
obscure  as  to  certain  archdeaconries  by  the 
subsequent  Cathedral  Reform  Act,  3  &  4 
Vict.  c.  113,  which  indifferent  ways  annexes 
some  archdeaconries  to  canonries.  So  much 
as  this  is  clear  from  the  first,  which  may  be 
called  the  Plurality  Act,  s.  2 :  that  nothing 
therein  shall  prevent  an  archdeacon  from 
holding  a  canonry  (annexed  or  not)  and  a 
living  in  his  archdeaconry  diocese,  the 
general  prohibition  there  being  against 
taking  any  third  preferment ;  and  an  arch- 
deaconry is  defined  by  s.  124  to  be  a  "  cathe- 
dral preferment,"  though  archdeacons  are 
not,  as  such,  members  of  the  chapter.  But 
the  Cathedral  Act  authorised  the  new  can- 
onry at  St.  Paul's  and  Lincoln  to  be  given 
by  the  bishops  only  to  one  of  their  arch- 
deacons, s.  33,  with  a  power  also  to  give  a 
third  part  of  its  endowment  to  another 
archdeacon,  who  is  also  to  be  reckoned  a 
holder  of  cathedral  preferment,  s.  35 ;  which 


ARCHIMANDRITE 

is  something  short  of  absolute  annexation,, 
and  requires  two  collations.  Opinions  of 
several  diocesan  chancellors  have  been  given, 
that  this,  and  h.  fortiori  absolute  annexation, 
overrides  the  prohibition  of  the  previous 
Act,  and  enables  the  holder  of  a  living  in 
another  diocese  to  take  an  archdeaconry  and 
canonry  of  London.  But  the  Act  is  so 
expressed  that  such  an  archdeacon  could 
not  take  a  fresh  living  out  of  the  diocese. 
And  s.  34  of  the  Cathedral  Act  requires 
all  newly  endowed  archdeacons  to  reside 
in  their  diocese  eight  months  a  year ;  while 
s.  38  of  the  Plurality  Act  allows  them  to 
reckon  as  residence  any  time  that  they  are 
visiting  "  or  otherwise  engaged  in  the  exer- 
cise of  archidiaconal  functions."  Probably 
the  author  did  not  know  what  he  meant 
thereby,  and  prohibitions  and  penalties  have 
to  be  construed  strictly.     [G.] 

ARCHES,  COURT  OF.  The  Court  of 
Arches  is  an  ancient  court  of  appeal,  belong- 
ing to  the  Archbishop  of  Canterbury,  where- 
of the  judge  is  called  the  Dean  of  Arches, 
because  he  anciently  held  his  court  in  the 
church  of  St.  Mary-le-Bow  (Santa  Maria  de 
Arcubus) ;  where  the  confirmation  of  the  elec- 
tion of  bishops  of  the  province  of  Canterbury 
still  takes  place  as  in  an  archiepiscopal  court. 
The  Court  of  Arches  used  to  sit  in  Doctors' 
Commons,  untU  that  establishment  was- 
broken  up  and  the  ecclesiastical  courts- 
thrown  open  to  the  bar  and  solicitors  in 
general,  and  all  the  probate  and  divorce 
business  taken  away,  and  referred  to  a 
common  law  judge  in  1857.  Since  then  it 
has  generally  sat  either  in  the  Lambeth 
Library  or  one  of  the  rooms  in  the  Houses 
of  Parliament.  A  room  still  remains  for  it  in 
Doctors'  Commons.  A  change  was  made 
also  in  its  constitution  by  the  Public 
Worship  Regulation  Act,  1874,  which  (after 
a  temporary  arrangement)  enacted  that  on 
the  next  vacancies  in  the  offices  of  the 
Dean  of  Arches  and  the  Provincial  Judge- 
of  York,  the  two  archbishops  should  appoint 
the  same  person  to  both  with  the  approval 
of  the  Crown,  or  the  Crown  alone  if  they  do- 
not  agree — a  mere  usurpation  of  the  Crown 
for  which  no  reason  was  even  alleged. 
The  two  provincial  judges  accordingly  re- 
signed very  soon,  and  Lord  Penzance,  who 
had  been  already  appointed  "a  judge"  of 
both  courts,  became  the  judge  of  both  pro- 
vinces ;  but  in  all  other  respects  the  old 
jurisdiction  was  retained,  as  was  decided 
finally  by  the  House  of  Lords  in  one  of  the 
many  phases  of  the  Mackonochie  case.  [G.] 

ARCHIMANDRITE.  The  word  is  de- 
rived from  fidvdpa,  literally  an  enclosed 
space,  and  so  a  fold  or  stable.  It  is  ex- 
plained in  old  glossaries  by  oTreor,  crTrriXaiov 
(Dufresne).  The  mandrite  at  first  would  be 
a  person  who  lived  in  a  solitary  cave ;   then 


AECHPEIEST 

the  cave  (for  caves  are  used  in  the  East  as 
folds)  would  gradually  enclose  a  fold  of 
monks.  The  head  was  called  the  archiman- 
drite, but  this  term  afterwards  was  limited 
to  a  general  abbot,  or  head  of  an  aggregation 
of  monasteries  {Cone.  Eph.  p.  751);  and  so 
the  word  is  still  used  in  Mt.  Athos.  In  the 
Russian  Church  archimandrites  are  the  heads 
of  superior,  the  Hegumens  of  inferior  mon- 
asteries. In  the  Coptic  Church  the  archi- 
mandrite is  second  only  in  dignity  to  the 
patriarch,  being  grand-prior  of  all  the  con- 
vents of  the  country. — Dr.  Newman's  note 
to  Fleury,  E.  Hist.  bk.  xxv.  43. 

AECHPEIEST,  or  ARCHPEESBYTER. 
An  ancient  title  of  distinction,  corresponding 
in  some  degree  to  our  title,  rural  dean. 
Mention  is  made  in  the  sixth  and  ninth 
centuries  of  arch  priests.  There  seem  to 
have  been  two  kinds  of  cures,  the  smaller 
governed  by  simple  priests,  and  the  bap- 
tismal churches  by  archpriests,  who  also 
had  the  inspection  of  the  other  inferior 
priests,  and  gave  account  of  them  to  the 
bishop.  There  are  archpresbyters  still  in 
the  Greek  Church,  with  authority  similar  to 
that  of  chorepiscopi.  (See  C/iorepiscopi.) 
The  archpriest  in  foreign  churches,  in  Italy 
especially,  answers  to  our  cathedral  dean: 
in  some  Italian  dioceses,  somewhat  to  our 
rural  dean.  The  title  was  revived  under 
most  unhappy  pretensions  among  the  Ro- 
manists of  England,  in  the  year  1598. 
These  men,  finding  themselves  without 
bishops,  importuned  the  pope,  Clement  VII., 
to  supply  their  need ;  but  instead  of  sending 
them,  as  they  desired,  a  number  of  bishops, 
he  gave  them,  or  rather  sanctioned,  one  eccle- 
siastical superior,  Robert  Blackwell,  who 
after  all  was  merely  a  priest ;  an  archpriest 
indeed  he  was  called,  but  as  such  having  no 
episcopal  power.  He  could  not  ordain 
priests,  confinn  children,  nor  consecrate 
chapels,  should  circumstances  permit  or 
require.  It  is  plain,  then,  that  the  arch- 
priest was  a  very  imperfect  and  insufficient 
substitute  for  a  bishop.  Neverthless 
English  Romanism  was  placed  under  the 
superintendence  of  three  archpriests  in  suc- 
cession ! — Darwell,  Visitation  Serm.;  Stubbs' 
Soames'  Mosheim,  iii.  392. 

AECHONTICS.  Heretics  who  appeared 
in  the  second  century,  about  a.d.  175,  and 
who  were  an  offshoot  of  the  Valentinians. 
They  held  strange  doctrines  concerning  the 
Divinity  and  the  creation  of  the  wrold, 
which  they  attributed  to  sundry  arch- 
spirits  (apxovres),  whence  probably  the  name 
of  the  sect,  but  others  derive  the  name  from 
an  anchorite  called  Archon,  said  to  be  their 
founder.  They  rejected  baptism. — Aug.  Essr. 
c.  20 ;  Epiphan.  adv.  Eser.  lib.  i.  iii.  40. 

ARIANS.  Heretics,  deriving  their  name 
from  Arius. 


ARIANS 


59 


I.  Eistory.  The  Divinity  of  the  Son  of 
God  was  a  subject  on  which  heresies  arose 
in  the  earliest  ages.  The  Gnostics,  the 
Ebionites,  Theodotas,  and  Paul  of  Samosata, 
with  others,  fell  into  error  on  this  vital 
point  of  Christian  doctrine  (Buseb.  Eccl. 
Eist.  V.  c.  28,  and  vii.  c.  30),  but  Arius 
reduced  the  erroneous  ideas  into  a  system, 
and  having  great  intellectual  power,  as  well 
as  personal  influence,  headed  a  great  schism. 
He  first  promulgated  his  theory,  as  it  is  said, 
at  a  convention  of  clergy  under  the  Bishop 
Alexander  of  Alexandria.  Afterwards  he 
and  his  followers  were  excommunicated 
by  a  council  of  100  bishops  of  Egypt  and 
Libya.  But  the  heresy  gained  ground, 
many  distinguished  men  upholding  him 
despite  the  firm  attitude  of  Alexander  and 
his  bishops,  and  in  a.d.  325  the  Empejor 
Constantime  called  together  the  first  council 
of  Nice,  at  which  318  bishops  were  present 
from  all  parts  of  the  world.  At  this  the 
word  "  homoousios,"  that  is,  of  "  the  same 
substance,"  was  adopted  with  regard  to  our 
Lord  in  order  to  express  the  exact  equality 
of  the  divine  nature  with  that  of  the  first 
person  of  the  Trinity.  Arius  was  ex- 
communicated, but,  three  years  afterwards, 
so  explained,  or  coloured  his  doctrine,  that 
Constantino  was  satisfied.  Athanasius,  the 
bishop  of  Alexandria,  however,  refused 
communion  to  Arius,  on  which  an  appeal 
was  again  made  to  the  emperor,  who  said, 
"  if  Arius'  profession  was  false,  God  would 
avenge  the  perjury,"  and  ordered  Alexander, 
bishop  of  Constantinople,  to  receive  Arius 
into  communion.  Alexander  refused,  but 
before  the  matter  came  to  a  crisis  Arius 
suddenly  died.  (Socrat.  Ecc.  Eist.  i.  c. 
38.)  But  the  spirit  of  Arianism  was  not 
checked.  Constantius,  the  successor  of 
Constantine,  abetted  it,  and  though  Jovian 
recalled  the  Catholic  bishops,  under  Valens 
it  flourished,  till  Theodosius  used  every 
means  to  suppress  it.  (Socrat.  iii.  53 ; 
Soz.  vi.  37.)  The  mischief  however  remained. 
The  Vandals  in  Africa,  the  Visigoths  in 
Prance  and  Spain,  had  been  converted  to 
Arianism ;  and  the  orthodox  were  grievously 
persecuted,  till  the  successes  of  Justinian, 
and  the  Council  of  Toledo  (a.d.  589),  es- 
tablished the  Catholic  faith  among  them. 
The  Lombards  in  Italy  remained  Arians  for 
nearly  100  years  after  (a.d.  673).  In  the  six- 
teenth century  this  heresy  was  revived,  and, 
as  was  the  custom  of  the  times,  much 
cruelty  was  displayed  towards  its  professors. 
Servetus,  a  Spaniard,  was  burnt  at  Geneva, 
Calvin  consenting,  and  Gentilis  was  beheaded 
at  Berne,  for  holding  Arian  doctrines.  The 
heresy  extended  to  Poland,  where  Anti-Trini- 
tarianism  obtained  a  great  hold. — Rees' 
trans,  of  Eacovian  Catechism,  p.  26  seg. 

In  England  one  George  Paris  was  burnt 


60 


AKIANS 


in  the  reiga  of  Edw.  VI.,  and  up  to  the  time  of 
James  1.  there  were  executions  for  Arianism, 
but  chiefly  of  ignorant  persons. 

In  the  seventeenth  century  Saunders  and 
Biddle  (see  Biddlians),  and  in  the  eighteenth 
Whiston  and  S.  Clarke,  held  opinions  ap- 
proaching Arianism.  Dr.  Clarke's  hook, 
'  The  Scripture  Doctrine  of  the  Trinity,'  was 
brought  under  the  notice  of  Convocation  in 
1713.  But  as  a  sect  Arianism  has  ceased 
to  exist,  though  there  are  traces  of  it  under 
other  denominations.  (See  Socinians ;  Uni- 
tarians.} 

II.  Doctrine.  The  doctrine  of  Arius  may 
he  thus  stated : — ^The  Son  sprang  not  from 
the  nature  of  the  Father,  but  was  created 
from  nothing ;  he  had,  indeed,  an  existence 
before  the  world,  even  before  time,  but  not 
from  eternity.  He  is,  therefore,  in  essence 
diBerent  from  the  Father,  and  belongs  to  the 
order  of  creatures,  whom  he,  however, 
precedes  in  excellence,  as  God  created  all 
things,  even  time,  by  his  instrumen- 
tality; whence  he  was  called  the  Son  of 
God,  the  Logos,  or  Word  of  God.  As  a 
creature  the  Son  is  perfect,  and  as  like  to 
the  Father  as  a  creature  can  be  to  the 
Creator.  But  as  he  has  received  all  things 
as  a  gift,  from  the  favour  of  the  Father, — 
as  there  was  a  period  in  which  he  was  not, — - 
so  there  is  an  infinite  distance  between  him 
and  the  nature  of  the  Father ;  of  which 
nature  he  cannot  even  form  a  perfect  idea, 
but  can  enjoy  only  a  defective  knowledge  of 
the  same.  His  will  was  originally  variable, 
capable  of  good  and  of  evil,  as  is  that  of  all 
other  rational  creatvires:  he  is,  comparatively 
at  least,  free  from  sin ;  not  by  nature,  but  by 
his  good  use  of  his  power  of  election ;  the 
Father,  therefore,  foreseeing  his  perse- 
verance in  good,  imparted  to  him  that 
dignity  and  sublimity  above  all  other 
creatures,  which  shall  continue  to  be  the 
reward  of  his  virtues.  Although  he  is  called 
God,  he  is  not  so  in  truth,  but  was  deified 
in  that  sense  in  which  men,  who  have 
attained  to  a  high  degree  of  sanctity,  may 
arrive  at  a  participation  of  the  Divine 
prerogatives.  The  idea  then  of  a  generation 
of  the  Son  from  the  essence  of  the  Father 
is  to  be  absolutely  rejected. 

This  doctrine,  which  must  have  corre- 
sponded to  the  superficial  understandings, 
and  to  the  yet  half-pagan  ideas,  of  many 
who  then  called  themselves  Christians, 
attacked  the  very  soul  of  the  Christian 
doctrine  of  the  redemption;  for,  according 
to  this  doctrine,  it  was  not  God  made  man, 
but  a  changeable  creature,  who  effected  the 
great  work  of  the  redemption  of  fallen  man. 
The  devout  Christian,  to  whom  faith  in  the 
God-man,  Christ,  the  only  Divine  Mediator, 
opened  the  way  to  an  intimate  union  with 
God,  saw  by  thjs  doctrine  that  his  Redeemer 


AEMENIANS 

and  Mediator  was  as  infinitely  removed  from 
the  essence  of  God  as  himself ;  he  saw  him- 
self driven  back  to  the  ancient  pagan 
estrangement  from  God,  and  removed  to 
an  unattainable  distance  from  him. — Dr. 
C.  Walch,  Sist.  der  Keizereien,  &c.,  vol. 
ii.  395,  &c. ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  283,  &c. ; 
Newman's  Fleury,  xviii.  1,  &c. ;  TUlemont's 
Hist.  ofArians,  trans,  by  Deacon,  1721 ;  Bp. 
Bull,  vol.  v.,  Clar.  ed  ;  Maimbourg,  Hist, 
of  Arians.  For  an  account  of  the  revival  of 
Arianism  in  the  last  century,  see  Van 
Milderts  Life  of  Waterland,  prefixed  tb 
Waterland's  Works,  vol.  i.    [H.] 

AEK  OP  THE  COVENANT.  So  the 
Jews  called  a  small  chest  or  cofier,  three  feet 
nine  inches  in  length,  two  feet  three  inches 
in  breadth,  and  two  feet  three  inches  in 
height  (Prideaux,  Connect.  Part  i.  Book 
iii.),  in  which  were  contained  "the  golden 
pot  that  had  manna,  and  Aaron's  rod,  and 
the  tables  of  the  covenant,"  as  well  the 
broken  ones  (according  to  the  Eabbins)  as 
the  whole.  (Heb.  ix.  4.)  Over  the  ark  was 
the  mercy-seat,  and  it  was  the  covering  of  it. 
It  was  made  of  solid  gold  (Exod.  xxv. 
17-22) ;  and  at  the  two  ends  of  it  were  two 
cherubims  looking  inward  toward  each  other, 
with  expanded  wings,  which,  embracing  the 
whole  circumference  of  the  mercy-seat,  met 
on  each  side  in  the  middle.  Over  this  the 
Shechrnah  glory  used  to  appear. 

What  became  of  the  old  ark,  on  the 
destruction  of  the  temple  by  Nebuchadnezzar 
is  a  dispute  among  the  fiabbins.  Had  it 
been  carried  to  Babylon  with  the  other 
vessels  of  the  temple,  it  would  have  been 
brought  back  again  with,  them,  at  the  end  of 
the  captivity.  But  that  it  was  not  so,  is 
agreed  on  all  hands ;  whence  it  is  probable 
it  was  destroyed  with  the  temple.  The 
Jews  contend,  that  it  was  hid  and  preserved 
by  Jeremiah.  Some  of  them  will  have  it, 
that  King  Josiah,  being  forewarned  by  Huldah 
the  prophetess  that  the  temple,  soon  after 
his  death,  would  be  destroyed,  caused  the 
ark  to  be  deposited  in  a  vaxilt,  which 
Solomon,  foreseeing  this  destruction,  had 
built  on  purpose  for  the  jireservation  of  it. — 
Buxtorf.  de  Area,  cap.  xxi.  xxii. 

AEMENIANS.  The  Christians  of  Ar- 
menia, the  first  country  in  which  Christianity 
was  recognised  as  the  national  religion,  in 
consequence  of  the  preaching  of  Gregory, 
called  Tlie  Illuminator,  in  the  beginning  of 
the  fourth  century.  It  has  been  commonly 
asserted  that  the  Armenians  fell  into  Nes- 
torian  and  Monophysite  errors,  but  an 
Armenian  Synod  held  in  a.d.  491  con- 
demned both  those  heresies;  and  it  has 
recently  been  denied  that  they  ever  held 
them. 

"L'Eglise  Arm^nienne  a  constamment 
reconnu   Je'sus-Christ    vrai    Dieu    et   vrai 


AKMINIANS 

homme;  par  consfiquent,  deux  natures  en 
une  personne,  la  personne  du  Verbe.  Ainsi, 
dans  tous  les  temps,  elle  a  rejete  les  erreui's 
opposfes  de  Nestorius  et  d'Butyclies. 

"  La  cause  principale,  et  presque  unique, 
des  discussions  qui  s'fleverent  parfois  entre 
les  Grecs  et  les  Armeniens,  c'est  I'ambiguite 
dumot  Armenien  pnoutioun  {(pia-is,  nature), 
qui  signifie  plus  proprement^e?-so?»»e. 

"  C'est  done  a  tort  que  quelques  auteurs 
donnent  aux  Armdniens  les  noms  de  mono- 
physites  et  d'eutycheens.  lis  n'ont  qn'k  lire 
le  discours  de  Jean  Otznitzi,  sumomme  le 
Philosophe,  patriarche  de  rArmenie  du  viii" 
siecle,  discours  public  a  Venise  avec  une 
traduction  latine,  par  le  P.  J.-B.  Aucher, 
I'an  1816.  Soumis  h,  I'examen  des  plus 
c^lebres  theologiens  de  Home,  ce  discours  fut 
reconnu  completement  conforme  a  la  doctrine 
de  I'Eglise  universelle. 

"  En  outre.  Saint  Nerses  Glai^tzi,  patri- 
arche de  I'Arm^nie  du  xii°  siecle,  dit  claire- 
ment : — '  Dire  aussi  deux  natures  en  J6sus- 
Christ,  k  cause  de  la  reunion  des  deux  en 
une  seule  personne,  n'est  pas  contraire  a 
la  v&ite,  si  toutefois  Ton  ne  divise  pas  en 
deux  I'unite.' 

"Saint  Nerses  Lampronatzi  plus  claire- 
ment  encore : — '  Dire  Jesus-Christ  Dieu  et 
homme,  et  le  dire  de  deux  natures,  c'est  la 
m^me  chose.' " 

[Letters  from  M.  Boghos  Dadiau  to  the 
Archbp.  of  Paris ;  published  by  Rev.  C.  G. 
Curtis,  Chaplain  of  Christ  Church,  Con- 
stantinople, in  the  Guardian,  May  13, 1885.] 

The  Armenians  do  not  deny  the  real 
presence  in  the  Eucharist :  they  administer 
in  both  kinds  to  the  laity :  they  do  not  mix 
■water  with  their  wine,  nor  do  they  consecrate 
unleavened  bread.  They  abstain  from  eating 
blood  and  things  strangled.  They  scrupu- 
lously observe  fasting:  they  administer 
the  Eucharist  to  infants:  they  reject 
purgatory  and  prayers  for  the  dead:  they 
fast  on  Christmas  day,  and  they  allow 
marriage  in  their  priests.  The  Armenians 
were  anciently  subject  to  the  patriarchs  of 
Constantinople,  but  they  now  have  their  own 
patriarchs,  three  in  nimiber,  of  whom  the 
chief  resides  in  a  monastery  at  Echmiazin,  the 
other  two  are  of  subordinate  rank.  (Stubbs' 
Soames'  Mosheim,  ii.  547;  Neale's  Hist, 
of  the  Eastern  Church,  vol.  ii.  8,  246.) 
Armenian  Christians  have  settled  for  com- 
mercial purposes  in  many  of  the  chief  cities 
of  Europe,  and  are  for  the  most  part  an 
intelligent  and  enterprising  people.  The 
Armenian  Convent  of  St.  Lazaro,  near  Venice, 
has  a  large  library  and  an  excellent  printing 
press  from  which  books  are  issued  printed  in 
thirty-two  languages.     [H.] 

AKMINIANS.  A  powerful  party  of 
Christians,  so  called  from  Arminius,  whose 
real  name  was   Harmensen,  latinized  into 


AKMINIANS 


61 


Arminius,  professor  of  divinity  at  Leyden, 
who  was  the  first  that  opposed  the  tlien 
received  doctrines  in  Holland,  of  an  absolute 
predestination.  They  took  the  name  of 
Remonstrants,  from  a  writing  called  a  Re- 
monstrance, which  was  presented  by  them 
to  the  States  of  Holland,  1609,  wherein  they 
reduced  their  peculiar  doctrines  to  these  five- 
articles  : — 

1.  That  God,  from  aU  eternity,  determined 
to  bestow  salvation  on  thoSe  who,  as  he  fore- 
saw, would  persevere  imto  the  end  in  their 
faith  in  Jesus  Christ;  and  to  inflict  ever- 
lasting punishment  on  those  who  should 
continue  in  their  unbelief,  and  resist,  to  the 
end  of  life,  his  Divine  assistance ;  so  that 
election  was  conditional ;  and  reprobation, 
in  like  manner,  the  result  of  foreseen  infideUty 
and  persevering  wickedness. 

2.  On  the  second  point,  they  taught.  That 
Jesus  Christ,  by  his  suffering  and  death, 
made  an  atonement  for  the  sins  of  man- 
kind in  general,  and  of  every  individual  in 
particular ;  that,  however,  none  but  those 
who  believe  in  him  can  be  partakers  of  that 
Divine  benefit. 

3.  On  the  third  article  they  held.  That 
true  faith  cannot  proceed  from  the  exercise 
of  our  natural  faculties  and  powers,  nor  from 
the  force  and  operation  of  free  will ;  since 
man,  in  consequence  of  his  natural  corruption, 
is  incapable  either  of  thinking  or  doing  any 
good  thing ;  and  that,  therefore,  it  is  necessary 
to  his  conversion  and  salvation,  that  he  be 
regenerated  and  renewed  by  the  operation  of 
the  Holy  Ghost,  which  is  the  gift  of  God, 
through  Jesus  Christ. 

4.  On  the  fourth  they  beheved.  That  this 
Divine  grace,  or  energy  of  the  Holy  Ghost, 
begins,  advances,  and  perfects  everything 
that  can  be  called  good  in  man  ;  and  that, 
consequently,  all  good  works  are  to  be  attri- 
buted to  God  alone ;  that  nevertheless,  this 
grace,  which  is  offered  to  all,  does  not  force 
men  to  act  against  their  inclinations,  but 
may  be  resisted  and  rendered  ineffectual 
by  the  perverse  will  of  the  impenitent 
sinner. 

5.  And  on  the  fifth,  That  God  gives  to 
the  truly  faithful,  who  are  regenerated  by 
his  grace,  the  means  of  preserving  themselves 
in  this  state ;  and,  though  the  first  Arminians 
entertained  some  doubt  with  respect  to  th& 
closing  part  of  this  article,  their  followers- 
uniformly  maintain.  That  the  regenerate  may 
lose  true  justifying  faith,  fall  from  a  state  of 
grace,  and  die  in  their  sins. 

The  Synod  of  Dort,  consisting  of  Dutch, 
French,  German,  and  Swiss  divines,  and 
held  in  1618,  condemned  these  opinions. 
But  the  synod  was  entirely  under  Calvinistic 
influence.  The  sect  of  Arminians  or  Re- 
monstrants still  exists  in  Holland.  The- 
largest    society    is    in    Rotterdam,    which 


62 


ARMS 


numbers  600  members.  (See  Hallam,  Lit. 
Hist,  of  Europe  (1855),  vol.  ii.  p.  431; 
Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  iiL  420  seq.; 
Adams'  Religious  World,  ii.  p.  245;  the 
works  of  Arminius  translated  by  Hichols.) 

ARMS.  Armorial  bearings,  whether 
borne  by  individuals  or  by  corporate  bodies 
and  corporations  sole:  among  which  are 
reckoned  bishops,  colleges,  and  other  eccle- 
siastical persons  and  bodies.  A  bishop 
empales  his  family  coat  with  the  arms  of  his 
see,  to  denote  his  spiritual  marriage  with  his 
Church ;  but  the  arms  of  the  see  occupy  the 
dexter  side  of  the  escutcheon,  or  tlie  side  of 
greater  honour.  When  a  bishop  is  married, 
he  empales  the  arms  of  his  wife  with  his  own 
family  coat,  on  a  separate  escutcheon ;  and 
this  escutcheon  is  placed  by  the  sinister  side 
of  the  shield,  empaling  his  own  coat  with 
the  arms  of  the  see.  Many  of  the  arms  of 
bishoprics  contain  allusions  to  the  spiritual 
character  of  the  person  who  bears  them. 
Thus  the  archbishops  of  Canterbury,  Armagh, 
and  Dublin,  each  bear  a  pall,  in  right  of 
their  sees ;  as  did  the  archbishop  of  York  till 
his  arms  were  changed  about  the  beginning 
of  the  .sixteenth  century  to  two  keys  crossed 
saltierwise,  and  a  crown  royal  in  chief. 
Colleges  often  assume  the  family  coat  of 
their  founder  as  their  arms. 

ARNOLDISTS.  FoUowers  of  Arnold  of 
Brescia  (a.d.  1135-1155)  who,  seeing  the 
great  evils  that  arose  from  the  enormous 
wealth  of  the  pontiffs,  bishops,  and  clergy, 
desired,  in  the  interests  of  the  Church,  that 
they  should  be  dispossessed.  Arnold  was 
strangled  by  the  orders  of  the  pope  (Adrian 
IV.),  his  body  was  burnt,  and  the  ashes  thrown 
into  the  Tiber,  to  prevent  the  people  from  pay- 
ing veneration  to  his  corpse,  but  his  followers 
were  numerous,  and  in  subsequent  times 
often  reappeared — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim, 
ii.  153 ;  Milman's  Lat.  Clirist.  iii.  274  seq. 

AETEMONITES.  A  sect  mentioned  by 
Eusebius  (Hist.  Ecc.  v.  28)  and  Epiphanius 
{Hxr.  lib.  iv.  464).  They  applied  philosophj' 
and  geometiy  to  the  explication  of  the 
Christian  doctrine.  But  the  history  of 
Artemon  is  obscure,  and  his  doctrine  is 
equally  so.  At  the  end  of  the  sixteenth  cen- 
tury one  Samuel  Crell  called  himself  an  Arte- 
monite,  in  order  to  distinguish  himself  from 
the  Socinians,  with  whom  he  did  not  fully 
agree. — Stubbs'  Moslieim,  i.  152. 

ARTICLES  OP  THE  CHURCH  OP 
ENGLAND.  In  the  great  movement  of  the 
sixteenth  century,  when  the  unsettlement  of 
the  old  mediajval  system  gave  occasion  to 
much  wild  speculation, "  every  man  challeng- 
ing to  himself  the  right  of  private  judgment, 
and  many  abusing  it "  (Blunt's  Reform.  223), 
it  was  necessary  for  such  religious  bodies  as 
had  thrown  off  the  allegiance  to  Rome  to 
draw  up    some  declarations  of   faith    and 


ARTICLES 

discipline,  stating  definitely  what  they  held 
and  what  they  rejected.  Therefore  there 
were  framed  and  published  on  the  continent 
several "  Confessions,"  or  Articles  of  Paith,  of 
which  the  Augsburg  Confession  was  chief. 
(See  Augsburg  Confession.")  It  was,  indeed, 
only  one  of  many.  Every  reformed  body 
put  out  its  own  confession.  Even  those  who 
retained  their  obedience  to  Rome  were 
obliged  to  define  their  position,  as  by  the 
promulgation  of  the  decrees  of  the  Council 
of  Trent,  and  the  Creed  of  Pope  Pius  IV. 

In  England,  where  the  Papal  Supremacy 
was  repudiated,  it  was  expressly  declared 
that  there  was  no  intention  "  to  decline  or 
vary  from  the  congregation  of  Christ's 
Church,  in  things  concerning  the  very 
Articles  of  the  Catholic  Faith,  or  in  any 
other  things  declared  by  Holy  Scripture, 
and  the  Word  of  God  necessary  to  salvation." 
This  was  in  1533.  Some  years  later,  in 
order  to  define  the  position  of  the  Church  of 
England  in  relation  to  (1)  the  Church  of 
Rome,  (2)  the  proceedings  of  the  continen- 
tal reformers,  (3)  the  revolutionary  spirit 
naturally  following  a  religious  reform,  or 
change,  certain  articles  were  drawn  up,  which 
were  afterwards  altered  and  modified. 

1.  The  Ten  Articles  were  issued  by  Henry 
VIII.  in  1536  "  for  the  purpose  of  removing 
difficulties  which  agitated  the  Church,  and 
establishing  Christian  quietness." 

These  were  prepared  by  a  committee  of 
divines,  under  the  direction  of  the  king,  and 
his  vicar-general,  Thomas  Cromwell,  and 
declared  that  "  while  the  worship  of  images, 
the  invocation  of  saints,  and  ceremonies  of 
public  worship  were  highly  profitable,  and 
to  be  retained,  they  had  no  power  in  them- 
selves to  remit  sin,  or  justify  the  soul." 
Convocation  embodied  these  articles  in  a 
book  called  "  The  Institution  of  a  Christian 
Man,"  but  it  was  better  known  as  the 
Bishop's  Rook,  and  was  signed  by  the  arch- 
bishops and  many  of  the  bishops,  and  put 
forth  with  all  the  influence  of  the  royal 
authority.  But  shortly  afterwards  a  call 
for  further  innovation,  or  reformation,  was 
made  which  resulted  in  the  framing  of  other 
articles. 

2.  The  Thirteen  Articles  (1538)  were  the 
result  of  the  controversy  between  the  two 
parties  headed  on  the  one  side  by  Cranmer 
and  Cromwell,  and  on  the  other  by  Gardiner. 
The  former  were  inclined  to  join  with  all 
those  reformers  of  the  Lutheran  school,  who 
in  the  face  of  the  extreme  Zwinglian  and 
Calvinistic  bodies  were  ready  to  acquiesce 
in  a  federation  on  the  basis  of  episcopal 
government,  in  which  the  Church  of  England 
should  take  the  lead.  At  a  conference  held 
at  Lambeth  between  Lutheran  and  Anglican 
divines,  these  articles  were  drawn  up, 
following   the  Augsburg   Confession,   with 


AETICLES 

icertaia  modifications  regarding  justification, 
the  rights  of  the  civil  authority,  and  the 
ibenefits  of  confessional  absolution.  But  the 
king  did  not  agree,  and  so  the  articles  were 
not  confirmed.  There  is  a  manuscript 
.-among  Archbishop  Cranmer's  papers  which 
is  interesting  not  only  as  containing  the 
result  of  this  conference,  but  also  as  suggest- 
ing the  groundwork  of  the  present  articles. 
The  influence  of  Gardiner  was  manifested  in 
the  next  edition  of  "  Articles." 

3.  The  Six  Articles  (1539)  were  brought 
forward  in  parliament  by  the  Duke  of 
Norfolk,  and  notwithstanding  the  strenuous 
■opposition  of  Cranmer  and  his  adherents, 
were  adopted,  and  afterwards  accepted  by 
■Convocation.  By  the  statute  of  the  six 
articles  (called  the  whip  with  six  strings) 
the  doctrine  of  transubstantiation,  the 
■communion  in  one  kind,  vows  of  chastity, 
the  use  of  private  masses,  the  celibacy  of  the 
•clergy,  and  auricular  confession,  were  made 
■obligatory,  and  severe  penalties  were  ordered 
for  those  who  held  or  expressed  contrary 
■opinions.  A  revised  version,  also,  of  the 
Bishop's  Book  was  published,  which  bore  the 
"title  of  "  A  Necessary  Doctrine  and  Erudition 
:for  any  Christian  Man,"  and  was  known  as 
the  King's  Book.  This  prevented  any 
further  action  in  King  Henry's  reign,  but 
-on  the  accession  of  Edward  VI.,  fresh 
measures  were  taken. 

4.  The  first  Prayer  Book  of  1549,  with  its 
preface,  might  have  been  thought  sufficient 
to  meet  every  want  of  the  Reformers. 
Nevertheless  it  was  deemed  expedient  to 
3)romulgate  a  more  complete  and  definite 
body  of  Articles,  and  so  Forty-two  Articles 
Tve'-e  drawn  up  "  and  agreed  upon  by  bishops 
and  other  learned  men  in  Synod  of  London, 

1552,  for  avoiding  of  controversy,  and  es- 
-tablishment  of  godly  concord  in  certain 
zuatters  of  religion."  These  were  published 
by  the  "King's  Commandment"   in  June 

1553,  with  the  order  that  all  beneficed 
clergymen  should  sign  them  on  pain  of 
deprivation.  But  the  death  of  Edward  put 
a,  stop  to  the  whole  proceeding. 

5.  When  Elizabeth  came  to  the  throne, 
pending  the  consideration  of  the  above- 
m.entioned  articles,  a  short  and  concise  code 
was  issued,  called  the  Eleven  Articles,  which 
.accepted  Holy  Scripture  as  the  basis  of  faith, 
.and  the  creeds  as  its  interpretation ;  defined 
the  authority  of  the  Church,  and  the 
Eoyal  Supremacy  ;  enjoined  the  use  of  the 
Prayer  Book  and  the  restoration  of  the  cup 
to  the  laity ;  rejected  private  masses,  and 
the  veneration  of  images  and  relics.  In 
the  meanwhile  the  forty-two  articles  were 
being  considered,  and  were  shortly  after 
leduced  to  their  present  form. 

6.  The  Tliirty-nine  Articles,  basea  on  the 
Forty-two  Articles  framed  by  Archbishop 


ARTICLES 


63 


Cranmer  and  Bishop  Ridley  with  the  advice 
of  many  bishops  and  divines,  whose  opinions 
were  asked  and  considered  (Burnet,  Hist. 
Sef.  vol.  ii.  343,  Ox.  Ed.),  in  the  reign  of 
Edward  VI.,  were  presented  by  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  Parker,  to  the  con- 
vocation of  the  province  of  Canterbury 
which  was  convened  with  the  parliament  in 
January,  1562,  and  by  the  convocation  they 
were  unanimously  approved.  In  1566  a 
biU  was  brought  into  parliament  to  confirm 
them.  The  bill  passed  the  Commons,  but 
by  the  queen's  command  was  dropped  in 
the  Lords.  In  1571  the  convocation  re- 
vised the  articles  of  1562,  and  made  some 
alterations  in  them.  In  the  same  year  an 
Act  was  passed,  "  to  provide  that  the  min- 
isters of  the  Church  should  be  of  sound 
religion."  It  enacted  that  all  ecclesiastical 
persons  should  subscribe  to  "  all  the  articles 
of  religion  which  only  contained  the  con- 
fession of  the  true  faith  and  of  the  sacraments, 
comprised  in  a  book  imprinted,  entitled 
'  Articles,'  whereupon  it  was  agreed  by  the 
archbishops  and  bishops,  and  the  whole 
clergy  in  convocation  holden  at  London,  iu 
the  year  of  our  Lord  God  1562,  according  to 
the  computation  of  the  Church  of  England, 
for  the  avoiding  of  diversities  of  opinions, 
and  for  the  establishing  of  consent  touching 
true  religion,  put  forth  by  the  queen's 
authority."  These  Articles  were  revised, 
and  some  small  alterations  made  in  them, 
in  the  year  1571 ;  since  which  time  they 
have  continued  to  be  the  criterion  of  the 
faith  of  the  members  of  the  Church  of 
England  on  the  subjects  to  which  they  relate. 
The  Articles  of  1562  were  drawn  up  in 
Latin  only  (in  reality  the  Articles  both  of 
1552  and  of  1562  were  set  forth  in  our 
authorized  English  version,  as  well  as  in 
Latin);  but,  in  1571,  they  were  subscribed 
by  the  members  of  the  two  houses  of  convo- 
cation, both  in  Latin  and  English;  and, 
therefore,  the  Latin  and  English  copies  are 
to  be  considered  as  equally  authentic.  The 
original  manuscripts,  subscribed  by  the 
houses  of  convocation,  were  burnt  in  the 
Fire  of  London ;  but  Dr.  Bennet  has  collated 
the  oldest  copies  now  extant,  and  it  appears 
that  there  are  no  variations  of  any  im- 
portance. 

"  These  Thirty-nine  Articles  are  arranged 
with  great  judgment  and  perspicuity,  and 
may  be  considered  under  fom-  general 
divisions :  the  first  five  contain  the  Christian 
doctrines  concerning  the  Father,  the  Son, 
and  the  Holy  Ghost ;  in  the  sixth,  seventh, 
and  eighth,  the  rule  of  faith  is  estabUshed ; 
the  ten  next  relate  to  Christians,  as  indi- 
viduals; and  the  remaining  twenty-ono 
relate  to  them,  as  they  are  members  of  a 
religious  society.  But,  as  all  confessions  of 
faith    have    had    a    reference    to    existing 


64 


AKTICLES 


heresies,  we  shall  here  find,  not  only  the 
positive  doctrines  of  the  Gospel  asserted ;  but 
also  the  principal  errors  and  corruptions  of 
the  Church  of  Eome,  and  most  of  the 
extravagancies  into  which  certain  Protestant 
sects  fell  at  the  time  of  the  Eeformation, 
rejected  and  condemned." — Bp.  Tomline. 

The  various  forms  through  which  the 
Articles  have  passed,  may  be  seen  in 
Cardwell's  Synodalia,  and  Documentary 
Annals,  and  in  Hardwick's  History  of  the 
Articles.  In  1615,  a  set  of  Articles  of  a 
Calvinistic  nature  were  compiled  by  the 
Irish  Convocation ;  but  it  does  not  appear 
that  they  ever  received  the  sanction  of 
parhament.  These,  however,  were  super- 
seded in  1635  by  the  English  Articles, 
which  were  then  adopted  by  the  Irish 
Convocation.  (See  Jntroduction  to  Stephens' 
Book  of  Common  Prayer,  from  the  Dublin 
MS.,  vol.  i.,  xxxvii.-xxxix.)     [H.] 

ARTICLES  OP  THE  CHRISTIAN 
FAITH.    (See  Creeds.) 

AETS.  One  of  the  faculties  in  which 
degrees  are  conferred  in  the  universities. 
In  the  English  and  Irish  universities  there 
are  two  degrees  in  arts,  that  of  bachelor 
and  that  of  master.  The  whole  circle  of 
the  arts  was  formerly  reduced  to  seven  sci- 
ences, grammar,  rhetoric,  logic,  arithmetic, 
geometry,  music,  and  astronomy ;  and  these 
again  were  divided  into  the  trivium,  includ- 
ing the  first  three,  and  the  quadrivium, 
including  the  remaining  four.  Music  is 
now  considered  as  a,  separate  faculty  at 
Oxford,  Cambridge,  and  Dublin ;  as  the 
degrees  of  doctor  and  bachelor  of  music  are 
given.  Grammar  was  a  separate  but 
subordinate  faculty  at  Oxford  and  Cam- 
bridge, in  which  there  were  three  degrees; 
doctor,  master,  and  bachelor.  There  is  an 
instance  in  Wood's  Athens  Oxon.,  of  a 
doctor  in  grammar  and  rhetoric  (Eobt. 
Whityndon,  1513).  The  last  record  of 
grammatical  degrees  at  Oxford  is  in  1568 ; 
at  Cambridge  in  1539.  The  faculty  of  arts 
is  called  that  of  philosophy  in  some  foreign 
and  more  modern  universities,  where  the 
degrees  are  doctor  and  candidate.      [H.] 

ASAPH,  Psalms  of.  One  of  the  three 
Temple  Choirs  bore  the  designation  of  the 
Sons  of  Asaph:  from  Asaph,  their  leader 
in  the  time  of  David.  They  were  descend- 
ants of  Gershom,  the  eldest  son  of  Levi. 
Twelve  Psalms  are  entitled  Psalms  of 
Asaph:  viz.  the  50th,  73rd,  74th,  75th, 
76th,  77th,  78th,  79th,  80th,  81st,  82nd,  and 
83rd.  Commentators  are  divided  in  opinion, 
as  to  whether  these  were  composed  or 
adopted  by  the  above-named  Asaph,  or  by 
one  of  the  same  name,  but  of  later  date,  or 
were  appropriated  to  the  peculiar  use  of  the 
Sons  of  Asaph  in  the  courses  of  attendance 
at  the  temple. 


ASCETICS 

ASCENSION  DAY.  This  holy  day  has- 
been  kept  in  the  Christian  Church  from  the 
earliest  times.  It  is  reckoned  by  the  com- 
piler of  the  Apostolic  Constitutions  among, 
the  other  great  festivals,  Christmas  day,  the 
Epiphany,  Easter,  and  Whitsunday;  and 
St.  Augustine  {Ep.  cxviii.  ad  Januar^y 
speaks  of  it  as  either  instituted  by  the 
Apostles,  or  by  some  early  and  numerously 
attended  councils  of  the  primitive  bishops,, 
whose  authority  he  considered  most  benefi- 
cial in  the  Church.  "  On  this  day,"  says 
St.  Chiysostom  (Chrys.  Eomil.  Ixii.  torn.  viL ; 
Homil.  XXXV  torn,  v.),  "  the  reconciliation 
between  God  and  mankind  was  completed, 
the  long  enmity  was  dissolved,  the  blasting, 
war  brought  to  an  end."  "  On  this  day, 
we,  who  had  been  sho^vn  to  be  unworthy  of 
earth,  were  raised  to  the  hope  of  heaven ; 
we,  who  were  not  fit  to  receive  dominion 
even  on  earth  below  were  exalted  to  the 
kingdom  which  is  above;  and  our  nature 
kept  out  by  cherubim  from  an  earthly 
paradise  may  now  sit  above  the  cherubim 
on  high."  Christ,  the  first-fruits  of  our 
nature,  having  obtained  this  perfection,  we 
that  are  His  members  may  hope  to  partake 
the  same  glory.  This  hope  the  returning 
day  of  His  ascension  should  ever  bring  into 
our  minds,  and  we  should  keep  it  for  the 
sustaining  of  our  hope,  and  in  thankfulness 
for  the  grace  it  brought.  It  is  one  of  the 
days  which  the  Church  especially  recom- 
mends for  the  receiving  of  the  Holy  Com- 
munion. (See  the  Special  Preface  in  the 
Communion  Office.)  It  is  difficult  to  ac- 
count for  the  too  prevalent  neglect  of  this 
high  festival  of  our  Church,  on  any  other 
ground  than  the  encroachment  of  worldly 
principles  upon  the  minds  of  men,  to  the 
displacing  of  the  principles  of  the  Church. 
Ascension  day  is  one  of  the  six  holy  days 
for  which  special  psalms  are  appointed. 
The  three  Rogation  days  are  appointed  to 
prepare  us  for  its  right  celebration,  and  yet, 
because  it  is  not  marked  by  worldly  festivi- 
ties, many  neglect  and  pass  it  by.  It  is 
observed  as  a  scarlet  day  at  Oxford  and 
Cambridge.  It  is  popularly  called  Holy 
Thursday.  By  27  Henry  VI.  cap.  5,  the 
holding  of  fairs  or  markets  was  prohibited 
on  Ascension  day,  as  well  as  on  other  high 
holidays,  and  on  Sundays,  &c. ;  making  au 
exception  however  of  the  four  Sundays  in 
harvest:  and  it  was  enacted  that  the  fair 
should  be  held  on  some  other  day  preceding 
or  following.  That  part  of  the  Act  which 
related  to  Sundays  in  harvest  was  repealed 
by  13  &  14  Vict.  cap.  23.  The  rest  of  the 
Act  remains  unrepealed. 

ASCETICS.  Men  in  the  second  century, 
who  made  profession  of  uncommon  degrees 
of  sanclity  and  virtue,  and  declared  their 
resolution  of  obeying  all  the  counsels  of 


ASCETICISM 

Christ,  in  order  to  tlieir  enjoying  com- 
munion with  God  here ;  and  also,  in  ex- 
pectation that,  after  the  dissolution  of  their 
mortal  hodies,  they  might  ascend  to  him 
with  the  greater  facility,  and  find  nothing 
to  retard  their  approach  to  the  supreme 
centre  of  happiness  and  perfeciion.  They 
looked  upon  themselves  as  prohihited  the 
use  of  things  which  it  was  lawful  for  other 
Christians  to  enjoy,  such  as  vrine,  flesh, 
matrimony,  and  commerce.  They  thought 
it  their  indispensable  duty  to  attenuate  the 
body  by  watchings,  abstinence,  labour,  and 
hunger.  '  They  looked  for  felicity  in  solitary 
retreats,  in  desert  places,  where,  by  severe 
and  assiduous  efforts  of  sublime  meditation, 
they  thought  to  raise  their  souls  above  all 
external  objects  and  all  sensual  pleasures. 
Both  men  and  women  unposed  upon  them- 
selves the  most  severe  tasks,  the  most 
austere  discipline ;  all  which,  however  it 
might  be  the  fruit  of  pious  intention,  was 
in  the  issue  extremely  detrimental  to 
Christianity,  and  tended  to  introduce  the 
doctrine  of  justification  by  inherent  right- 
eousness. These  persons  were  called  ascetics 
(from  aaicrja-is,  exercise  or  discipline)  and 
philosophers;  nor  were  they  only  distin- 
guished by  their  title  from  other  Christians, 
but  also  by  their  garb.  In  the  second 
century,  indeed,  such  as  embraced  this 
austere  kind  of  life  submitted  themselves  to 
all  these  mortifications  in  jirivate,  without 
breaking  asunder  their  social  bonds,  or 
withdrawing  themselves  from  the  concourse 
of  men.  But  in  process  of  time,  they 
retired  into  deserts ;  and,  after  the  example 
of  the  Essenes  and  TherapeutaB,  they  formed 
themselves  into  certain  companies. — Origen, 
contr.  Oels.  lib.  v. ;  Bingham,  Antiq.  Chr. 
Ch.  bk.  vii.  c.  3  ;  Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim, 
1. 176. 

ASCETICISM.  (S<TKr,<Tcs,  used  by  hea- 
then writers  to  express  the  training  of  ath- 
letes.—Hipp.  Vet.  Med.  10.) 

I.  In  the  first  place  this  implies  the 
practice  of  the  ascetics,  who  often  gave 
up  the  ordinary  duties  of  life  and  went 
into  deserts,  &c.,  in  order  to  practise  extreme 
austerities  (see  preceding  art.);  though  all 
did  not  so  act.  They  are  called  by  Eusebius 
and  Epiphanius  o-n-ovSatoi. 

IL  The  word  also  implies,  in  accordance 
with  its  derivation,  the  practice  of  those 
who  endeavour,  like  St.  Paul,  to  bring  their 
bodies  into  subjection  (1  Cor.  ix.  517)  by 
rules  of  self-denial  and  abstinence  without 
neo-lecting  the  duties  of  their  position  in 
life.  Such  a  one,  in  ancient  times,  was 
Daniel,  who  though  surrounded  by  luxury, 
and  busied  with  the  cares  and  duties  of  his 
exalted  position,  always  adhered  to  his  pre- 
scribed rules.  But  there  is  no  need  to  look 
further  than  to  the  example  of  our  Blessed 


ASH-WEDNESDAY 


C5 


Lord,  Who,  while  He  mingled  with  the  feasts 
of  sinners,  yet  ever  Kved  a  life  of  abstinence, 
prayer,  poverty,  and  obedience,  that  "He 
might  do  the  will  of  Him  that  sent  Him."  The 
spirit  of  asceticism,  in  this  sense,  the  Church 
has  always  encouraged,  by  appointing  days 
and  seasons  for  abstinence  and  fasting.  At 
different  times  bodies  of  Christians  have 
formed  rules  of  greater  strictness  for  them- 
selves (as  in  the  case  of  the  Methodists),  and 
private  individuals  constantly  do  so.  The 
danger  is  that  men  are  apt  to  regard  the 
carrying  out  such  rules  of  an  ascetic  cha- 
racter as  meritmg  salvation  instead  of,  as 
was  always  intended,  a  training  of  the  body, 
that  it  may  be  subject  to  the  spirit.     [H.] 

ASCODRUGIT.a;.  A  fanatical  sect  at  the 
end  of  the  second  century.  They  used  to 
dance  round  an  ornamented  wine-skin  (aa-Kos) 
as  part  of  their  mysteries.  They  denied  the 
validity  of  sacraments,  and  are  named 
amongst  those  for  suppression  in  the  Con- 
stitution of  Theodosius. — Cod.  Theod.  xvi., 
v.  65. 

ASCODRUTES,  or  ASCODEOUTES. 
An  heretical  sect  of  the  Marcosians.  They 
rejected  the  sacraments,  alleging  that  things 
spiritual  cannot  be  conveyed  in  corporeal 
symbols.  Perfect  spiritual  knowledge  was 
their  redemption. — Bingham,  Antiq.  Chr. 
Ch.  bk.  xi.  2,  and  xv.  2. 

ASHES.  Several  reUgious  ceremonies 
depend  upon  the  use  of  ashes.  St.  Jerome 
relates,  that  the  Jews,  in  his  time,  rolled 
themselves  in  ashes,  as  a  sign  of  mourning. 
To  repent  in  sackcloth  and  ashes  is  a 
frequent  expression  in  Scrij)tm-e,  for  mourn- 
ing and  being  afflicted  for  our  sins.  (Numb. 
xix.  17,  &c.)  In  the  Roman  Church,  ashes  are 
given  among  the  people  on  Ash-AVednesday : 
they  must  be  made  from  branches  of  olive, 
or  some  other  trees,  that  have  been  blessed 
the  foregoing  year.  (JPescara  Cerem.  Eccles. 
Bom.)  The  sacristan,  or  vestry-keeper, 
prepares  these  ashes,  and  lays  them  in  a 
small  vessel  on  the  altar :  after  which  the 
officiating  priest  blesses  the  ashes,  which 
are  strewed  by  the  deacons,  and  assistants, 
on  the  heads  of  all  that  are  present,  accom- 
panied with  these  words,  Memento,  homo, 
quod  pulvis  es,  &c. ;  Bemember,  man,  that 
thou  art  dust,  &c. — Beligious  Ceremonies  of 
all  Nations,  vol.  iii.    (See  Ash- Wednesday.) 

ASH-WEDNESDAY.  (See  Lent  and 
Commination.)  This  day  seems  to  have 
been  observed  as  the  first  day  of  Lent  in 
the  time  of  Gregory  the  Great.  It  is 
supposed  by  some,  that  Gregory  added  three 
days  at  the  beginning  of  Lent,  to  make  the 
number  forty,  in  more  exact  imitation  of 
the  number  of  days  in  our  blessed  Saviour's 
fast;  and  that  before  his  time  there  were 
only  thirty-six  days,  the  Sundays  being 
always  kept  as  festivals.     It  was  called,  in 


6G 


ASPEEGILLUM 


his  time,  Dies  cinerum,  the  day  of  sprinkling 
ashes,  or  Caput  jejunii,  the  beginning  of 
the  fast.  The  custom  of  open  penance, 
which  the  name  of  the  day  reminds  us  of, 
is  one  of  those  things  which  the  Church  of 
England,  at  the  time  of  the  Eeformation, 
wished  to  see  restored ;  but  on  account  of 
the  prejudices  of  the  time,  she  could  not 
carry  out  her  wishes.  (See  tlie  Commination 
Service  in  the  Prayer  Book.) 

ASPERGILLUM.  A  brush,  used  in  the 
Roman  Catholic  Church  for  the  purpose  of 
sprinkling  holy  water  over  objects  to  be 
blessed. 

ASPERSION.  The  sprinklmg  with  water 
in  the  sacrament  of  baptism.  This  was 
granted  originally  only  in  cases  of  emer- 
gency, but  in  subsequent  times  was  very 
generally  substituted  for  immersion.  Our 
Rubric,  however,  orders  "  affusion,"  or  pour- 
ing the  water  instead  of  sprinkling.  (See 
Affusion.) 

It  is  said  by  the  Anabaptists  that  there 
is  no  authority  in  Scripture  for  thus  ad- 
-  ministering  the  sacrament  of  baptism.  But 
we  find  in  the  primitive  Church,  that  al- 
though baptism  was  regularly  administered 
by  immersion,  yet  in  cases  of  sickness, 
where  clinic  baptism  was  administered, 
aspersion  was  used.  We  conclude,  then, 
that  immersion  is  not  essential  to  the  sacra- 
ment; and  if  sickness  were  an  excuse  for 
not  immersing  under  certain  circumstances, 
it  is  stUl  a  sufficient  excuse,  if  in  our  cold 
climate  to  immerse  our  children  would  be 
attended  with  danger.  (See  Bingham,  A7it. 
xi.  i.  9,  and  xi.  5.) 

ASSEMBLY  OP  DIVINES.  The  title 
given  to  a  notable  assembly  held  at  West- 
minster, 1st  July,  1643,  convoked  by  an 
ordinance  of  the  Lords  and  Commons,  but 
forbidden  to  be  held  by  the  king,  to  take 
the  liturgy,  government,  and  doctrines  of 
the  Church  under  consideration.  The 
members  were  elected  by  the  knights  and 
burgesses,  two  being  returned  for  each 
county.  According  to  Clarendon  (vol.  iv. 
p.  260  seq..  Ox.  Ed.),  they  were  most  of 
them  men  of  mean  learning,  and  some  of 
them  of  scandalous  morals.  Among  the 
exceptions  to  this  condemnatory  sentence 
were  Lightfoot  and  Selden.  Usher  was 
nominated,  but  vrith  the  few  Episcopalians 
elected  did  not  serve.  The  Scottish  cove- 
nant was  taken  by  this  assembly :  and  the 
confession  of  faith  still  received  in  the 
Scottish  Presbyterian  establishment,  and 
the  larger  and  shorter  catechisms,  were 
drawn  up.  But  the  opinions  of  the  mem- 
bers differed  so  widely  on  many  points,  that 
the  assembly  broke  up  without  accom- 
plishing the  principal  end  for  which  it  was 
convened.     (See  Confessions  of  Faith.) 

ASSUMPTION    OP     THE     VIRGIN 


ATONEMENT 

MARY.  A  festival  of  the  Romish  Church 
instituted  in  the  seventh  century,  and  fixed 
to  the  15th  of  August,  in  honour  of  the  im- 
aginary ascension  of  the  Virgin  Mary  into 
heaven,  which,  without  any  authority  from 
Scripture  or  tradition,  some  in  that  Church 
teach  to  have  oocuiTed  in  a  miraculous 
manner,  some  years  after  her  death.  In 
the  early  Calendars  the  festival  was  called  the 
"  Dormitio,"  "  Koifiijo-iy,"  or  "  Mfraoraa-tj," 
of  the  "most  holy  Mother  of  God;"  the 
Assumption  being  a  more  recent  name. 
(See  Virgin  Mary.) 

ASYLUM.  A  place  of  refuge.  The 
right  of  protecting  from  arrest  all  persons 
who  fled  for  refuge  within  the  walls  of 
churches  began  to  be  a  privilege  of  the 
Church  in  the  time  of  Constantine.  At 
first  the  privilege  was  confined  to  the  choir, 
but  it  was  afterwards  extended  to  the  nave, 
and  finally  to  the  precincts  of  some  churches. 
In  the  middle  ages  this  was  sometimes  an 
advantage,  to  prevent  the  excesses  of  private 
revenge ;  but  in  time  it  became  an  abuse, 
and  the  privilege  was  taken  away. — Stubbs' 
Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  461 ;  Bingham,  bk.  viii. 
c.  11.     (See  Sanctuary.) 

ASSURANCE.  A  doctrine  which  has 
been  developed  from  the  word  wXi/poAopia 
(Col.  ii.  2;  1  Thess.  i.  5;  Heb.  vi.  11; 
xii.),  and  implies  that  to  truly  converted 
persons  there  is  a  perfect  assurance  of  peace 
with  God  —  present  pardon,  and  future 
salvation.  While  there  is  a  substratum  of 
truth  in  this  doctrine,  certain  sects  of 
Dissenters  use  it  so  as  almost,  if  not  quite, 
to  bring  them  \inder  the  denomination  of 
Antinomians. 

ATHANASIAN  CREED.     (See  Creeds.) 

ATHEIST.  (Prom  d  and  eeos,  without 
God.)  One  who  denies  the  being  and 
moral  government,  or  what  is  called  the 
personality  of  God. 

The  heathen,  who  vied  with  heretics  in 
giving  names  of  opprobrium  to  true  Chris- 
tians, called  the  primitive  Christians  Athe- 
ists, because  they  did  not  worship  their 
gods. 

ATONEMENT.  (See  Propitiation,  Co- 
venant of  Redemption,  Sacrifice,  and  Jesus 
Christ.)  The  word  atonement  signifies  an 
act  of  reconciliation.  The  etymology  of  the 
word  conveys  the  idea  of  two  parties,  pre- 
viously at  variance,  being  set  at  one  again, 
and  hence  at-one-ment,  from  originally 
signifying  reconciliatiim,  comes,  by  a  natural 
metonymy,  to  denote  that  by  which  the  re- 
conciliation is  effected.  The  earliest  au- 
thority for  the  noun  "  Atonement "  in  our 
language  is  our  Authorized  Version,  and  it 
was  evidently  used  by  the  translators  as 
better  signifying  the  sense  than  the  word 
"  reconciliation."  The  doctrine  of  the  atone- 
ment is  thus  stated  in  the  2nd  Article  of 


ATTRITION 

our  Church :  "  The  Son,  which  is  the  Word  of 
the  Father,  begotten  from  everlasting  of  the 
Father,  the  very  and  eternal  God,  and  of  one 
substance  with  the  Father,  took  man's  nature 
in  the  womb  of  the  blessed  Virgin,  of  her 
substance ;  so  that  two  whole  and  perfect 
natures,  that  is  to  say,  the  Godhead  and 
the  Manhood,  were  joined  together  in  one 
person,  never  to  be  divided,  whereof  is  one 
Christ,  very  God  and  very  Man ;  who 
truly  suffered,  was  crucified,  dead  and 
buried,  to  reconcile  his  Father  to  us,  and 
to  be  a  sacrifice,  not  only  for  original  guilt, 
but  also  for  actual  sins  of  men." — Article  2. 
But  it  is  to  be  observed  that  all  the  early 
writers  of  the  Catholic  Church  invariably 
speak  of  the  reconciliation  of  man  to  God, 
not  of  God  to  man,  and  this  appears  to  be 
more  consonant  to  the  language  of  Holy 
Scripture  in  the  passages  cited  above,  and 
in  others  where  the  incarnation  and  death 
of  Jesus  Christ  are  represented  as  the 
result  of  God's  abiding  love  for  man.  (St. 
Paul,  Col.  i.  20;  Eom.  v.  9,  10;  Heb.  ix. 
14 :  X.  19 ;  1  Peter  i.  2 :  i.  19 ;  1  John 
i.  7 ;  Eev.  v.  9,  10,  &c.) 

ATTEITION.  (See  Contrition?)  The 
casuists  of  the  Church  of  Rome  have  made 
a  distinction  between  a  perfect  and  an  im- 
perfect contrition.  The  latter  they  call 
attrition,  which  is  the  lowest  degree  of 
repentance,  or  a  sorrow  for  sin  arising  from 
a  sense  of  shame,  or  any  temporal  incon- 
venience attending  the  commission  of  it, 
or  merely  from  fear  of  the  punishment  due 
to  it,  without  any  resolution  to  sin  no  more : 
in  consequence  of  which  doctrine,  they 
teach  that,  after  a  wicked  and  flagitious 
course  of  life,  a  man  may  be  reconciled  to 
God,  and  his  sins  forgiven,  on  his  death- 
bed, by  confessing  them  to  the  priest  with 
this  imperfect  degree  of  sorrow  and  re- 
pentance, whereas  contrition  by  itself  is  of 
no  avail.  Psenitens  ex  attrito  virtute  abso- 
lutionis,  fit  contritus,  et  justificatur  (Bel- 
larmine,  Pxn.  ii.  18).  "  Therefore,"  says 
Jeremy  Taylor,  "  there  is  no  necessity  of 
contrition  at  all;  and  attrition  is  as  good, 
to  all  intents  and  purposes  of  pardon :  and  a 
little  repentance  will  prevail  as  well  as  the 
greatest,  the  imperfect  as  well  as  the 
perfect !  "  (Taylor's  Works,  vol.  x.  p.  190, 
Heber's  Ed.)  This  distinction  was  settled  for 
the  Church  of  Eome  by  the  Council  of  Trent. 
{Cone.  Trident,  sess.  xiv.  cap.  4.)  It  might  be 
easily  shown  that  the  mere  sorrow  for  sin 
because  of  its  consequences,  and  not  on 
account  of  its  evil  nature,  is  no  more 
acceptable  to  God  than  hypocrisy  itself 
>can  be. 

AUDIENCE,  COURT  OF.  The  Court 
■of  Audience,  which  belongs  to  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  was  for  the  disposal 
of  such  matters,  whether  of  voluntary  or 


AUGSBURG 


07 


contentious  litigation,  as  the  archbishop 
thought  fit  to  reserve  for  his  own  hearing. 
This  court  was  afterwards  removed  from 
the  archbishop's  palace,  and  the  jurisdiction 
of  it  exercised  by  the  master-ofiicial  of  the 
audience,  who  presided  in  the  Consistory 
Court  at  St.  Paul's.  But  now  the  three 
offices  of  official-principal  of  the  archbishop, 
dean  or  judge  of  the  peculiars,  and  official 
of  the  audience,  being  vmited  in  the  person 
of  the  judge  appointed  under  the  provisions 
of  the  Public  Worship  Regulation  Act,  its 
jurisdiction  belongs  to  him.  The  Arch- 
bishop of  York  had  likewise  his  Court  of 
Audience,  now  merged  in  the  same  court  of 
both  provinces. 

AUGSBURG  or  AUGUSTAN  CON- 
FESSION. 

I.  The  gradual  progress  of  the  Refor- 
mation movement  was,  early  in  the  six- 
teenth century,  impeded  by  the  rise  of 
Anabaptism,  and  the  difference  between  the 
German  and  Swiss  Reformers  with  regard 
to  the  Holy  Eucharist.  There  seemeii  to 
be  no  possibility  of  agreement  on  the  latter 
subject,  Luther  considering  the  points  of  dif- 
ference as  fundamental.  The  Emperor 
Charles  V.  urged  Pope  Clement  VII.  to 
convoke  a  general  council  for  the  Scriptural 
determination  of  all  controversies;  but  the 
pope  refused.  A  diet  of  the  German 
princes  was  therefore  convened  in  1530  by 
the  Emperor  Charles  V.,  to  meet  in  the 
city  of  Augsburg,  on  April  8,  for  the 
express  purpose  of  pacifying  the  religious 
troubles,  by  which  most  parts  of  Germany 
were  then  distracted.  "  In  his  journey 
towards  Augsburg,"  says  Dr.  Robertson, 
"the  emperor  had  many  opportunities  of 
observing  the  dispositions  of  the  Germans, 
in  regard  to  the  points  in  controversy,  and 
found  their  minds  everywhere  so  much 
irritated  and  inflamed,  that  nothing  tending 
to  severity  or  rigour  ought  to  be  attempted, 
till  the  other  methods  proved  ineffectual. 
His  presence  seems  to  have  communicated 
to  all  parties  an  universal  spirit  of  mode- 
ration and  desire  of  peace.  With  such 
sentiments,  the  Protestant  princes  employed 
Melanchthon,  the  man  of  the  greatest  learn- 
ing, as  well  as  the  most  pacific  and  gentlest 
spirit  among  the  Reformers,  to  draw  up  a 
confession  of  faith,  expressed  in  terms  as 
little  offensive  to  the  Roman  Catholics  as 
a  regard  to  truth  would  admit.  Melanch- 
thon, who  seldom  suffered  the  rancour  of 
controversy  to  envenom  his  style,  even  in 
writings  purely  polemical,  executed  a  task, 
so  agreeable  to  his  natural  disposition,  with 
moderation  and  success."  (Charles  F.  ii.  256.) 

The  Confession  was  read,  at  a  full  meet- 
ing of  the  diet,  on  June  25,  by  the  chancel- 
lor of  the  elector  of  Saxony.  It  was  sub- 
scribed  by  that   elector,  and   three  other 

r  2 


68 


AUGSBURG 


princes  of  the  German  empire,  and  tlien 
delivered  to  the  emperor. 

II.  The  singular  importance  of  this  docu- 
ment of  Protestant  faith  seems  to  require, 
in  this  place,  a  particular  mention  of  its 
contents.  It  consists  of  twenty-one  articles. 
The  subscribers  of  it  acknowledge — 1.  The 
unity  of  God  and  the  trinity  of  persons. 
2.  Original  sin.  3.  The  two  natures  and 
imity  of  person  in  Jesus  Christ,  and  all  the 
other  articles  contained  in  the  symbol  of 
the  apostles,  respecting  the  Son  of  God. 

4.  They  declare  that  men  are  not  justified 
before  God  by  their  works  and  merits,  but 
by  the  faith  which  they  place  in  Jesus 
Christ,  when  they  believe  that  God  for- 
gives their  sins  out  of  love  for  his   Son. 

5.  That  the  preaching  of  the  Gospel  and  the 
sacraments  are  the  ordinary  means  used  by 
Grod  to  infuse  the  Holy  Ghost,  who  pro- 
duces faith,  whenever  he  wills,  in  those 
that  hear  his  word.  6.  That  faith  produces 
the  good  works  to  which  men  are  obliged 
by  the  commandments  of  God.  7.  That 
there  exists  a  perpetual  Church,  which  is 
the  assembly  of  saints ;  and  that  the  word 
of  God  is  taught  m  it  with  purity,  and  the 
sacraments  administered  in  a  legitimate 
manner;  that  the  unity  of  this  Church 
consists  in  the  uniformity  of  doctrine  and 
sacraments;  but  that  an  uniformity  of 
ceremonies  is  not  requisite.  8.  They 
profess  that  the  word  of  God  and  the 
sacraments  have  still  their  eflScacy,  al- 
though administered  by  wicked  clergyroen. 

9.  That  baptism  is  requisite  for  salvation, 
and  that  little  children  ought  to  be  baptised. 

10.  That,  in  the  sacrament  of  the  last 
supper,  both  the  body  and  blood  of  the 
Lord  are  truly'  present,  and  distributed  to 
those  who  partake  of  it.  11.  That  con- 
fession must  be  preserved  in  the  Church, 
but  without  insisting  on  an  exact  enume- 
ration of  sins.  12.  That  penance  consists 
of  contrition  and  faith,  or  the  persuasion, 
that,  for  the  sake  of  Jesus  Christ,  our  sins 
are  forgiven  us  on  our  repentance ;  and  that 
there  is  no  true  repentance  without  good 
works,  which  are  its  inseparable  fruits. 
13.  That  the  sacraments  are  not  only  signs 
of  the  profession  of  the  Gospel,  but  proofs 
of  the  love  of  God  to  men,  which  serve  to 
excite  and  confirm  their  faith.  14.  That  a 
vocation  is  requisite  for  pastors  to  teach  in 
the  Church.  15.  That  those  ceremonies 
ought  to  be  observed  which  keep  order  and 
peace  in  the  Church ;  but  that  the  opinion 
of  their  being  necessary  to  salvation,  or  that 
grace  is  acquired,  [or  satisfaction  done  for 
our  sins,  by  them,  must  be  entirely  ex- 
ploded. 16.  That  the  authority  of  magis- 
trates, their  commands  and  laws,  with  the 
legitimate  wars  in  which  they  may  be 
forced  to  engage,  are  not  contrary  to  the 


AUGSBURG 

Gospel.  17.  That  there  will  be  a  judg- 
ment, where  all  men  will  appear  before 
the  tribunal  of  Jesus  Christ ;  and  that 
the  wicked  will  suffer  eternal  torments. 
18.  That  the  powers  of  free-will  may  produce 
an  exterior  good  conduct,  and  regidate  the 
morals  of  men  towards  society;  but  that, 
without  the  grace  of  the  Holy  Ghost, 
neither  faith,  regeneration,  nor  true  justice 
can  be  acquired.  19.  That  God  is  not  the 
cause  of  sin,  but  that  it  arises  only  from 
the  corrupt  will  of  man.  20.  That  good 
works  are  necessary  and  indispensable ;  but 
that  they  cannot  purchase  the  remission  of 
sins,  which  is  only  obtained  in  consideration 
of  faith,  which,  when  it  is  sincere,  must 
produce  good  works.  21.  That  the  virtues 
of  the  saints  are  to  be  placed  before  the 
people,  in  order  to  excite  imitation ;  but 
that  the  Scripture  nowhere  commands  their 
invocation,  nor  mentions  anywhere  any 
other  mediator  than  Jesus  Christ.  "  This," 
say  the  subscribers  of  the  Confession,  "is 
the  summary  of  the  doctrine  taught  amongst 
us;  and  it  appears  from  the  exposition 
which  we  have  just  made,  that  it  contains 
nothing  contrary  to  Scripture ;  and  that  it 
agrees  with  that  of  the  Catholic  Church, 
and  even  with  the  Roman  Church,  as  far 
as  is  known  to  us  by  their  writers.  This 
being  so,  those  who  wish  that  we  should 
be  condemned  as  heretics  are  very  unjust. 
If  there  be  any  dispute  between  us,  it  is 
not  upon  articles  of  faith,  but  only  upon 
abuses  that  have  been  introduced  into  the 
Church,  and  which  we  reject.  This,  there- 
fore, is  not  a  sufScient  reason  to  authorize 
the  bishops  not  to  tolerate  us,  since  we  are 
agreed  in  the  tenets  of  faith  which  we 
have  set  forth :  there  never  has  been  an 
exact  uniformity  of  exterior  practice  since 
the  beginning  of  the  Church,  and  we  pre- 
serve the  greater  part  of  the  established 
usages.  It  is  therefore  a  calumny  to  say, 
that  we  have  abolished  them  all.  But,  as 
all  the  world  complained  of  the  abuses 
that  had  crept  into  the  Church,  we  have 
corrected  those  only  which  we  could  not 
tolerate  with  a  good  conscience;  and  we 
entreat  your  Majesty  to  hear  what  the 
abuses  are  which  we  have  retrenched,  and 
the  reasons  we  had  for  doing  it.  We  also 
entreat,  that  our  inveterate  enemies,  whose 
hatred  and  calumnies  are  the  principal 
cause  of  the  evil,  may  not  be  believed." 

They  then  proceed  to  state  the  abuses 
in  the  Church  of  Rome,  of  which  they 
complain.  The  first  is  the  denial  of  the 
cup  in  the  sacrament  of  the  Lord's  supper ; 
the  second,  the  celibacy  of  the  clergy ;  the 
third,  the  form  of  the  mass.  On  this  head 
their  language  is  very  remarkable:  "Our 
Churches,"  they  say,  "  are  unjustly  accused 
of  having  abolished  the  mass,  since  they 


AUGSBUEG 

celebrate  it  with  great  veneration:  they 
even  preserve  ahiiost  all  the  accustomed 
ceremonies,  having  only  added  a  few  Ger- 
man hymns  to  the  latter,  in  order  that  the 
people  may  profit  by  them."  But  they 
object  to  the  multiplicity  of  masses,  and 
to  the  payment  of  any  money  to  a  priest 
for  saying  them.  The  fourth  abuse  of 
which  tbey  complain,  is  the  practice  of 
auricular  confession :  but,  they  observe, 
that  they  have  only  taken  from  it  the 
penitent's  obligation  to  make  to  the  priest 
a  particular  enumeration  of  his  sins,  and 
that  they  had  retained  the  confession  itself, 
and  the  obligation  of  receiving  absolution 
from  the  priest.  The  fifth  abuse  is  the 
injunction  of  abstinence  from  particular 
meats.  Monastic  vows  they  represent  as 
the  sixth  abuse.  The  seventh  and  last 
abuse  of  which  they  complain,  is  that  of 
ecclesiastical  power.  They  say  that  "a 
view  of  the  attempts  of  the  popes  to  ex- 
communicate princes,  and  dispose  of  their 
states,  led  them  to  examine  and  fix  the 
distinction  between  the  secular  and  eccle- 
siastical power,  to  enable  themselves  to 
give  to  CjESar  what  belongs  to  Caesar,  and 
to  the  popes  and  bishops  what  belongs  to 
them."  That  "ecclesiastical  power,  or  the 
power  of  the  keys,  which  Jesus  Christ 
gave  to  his  Church,  consisted  only  of  the 
power  of  preaching  the  Gospel,  of  adminis- 
tering the  sacraments,  the  forgiveness  of 
sins,  and  refusing  absolution  to  a  false 
penitent :  therefore,"  say  they,  "  neither 
popes  nor  bishops  have  any  power  to  dis- 
pose of  kingdoms,  to  abrogate  the  laws  of 
magistrates,  or  to  prescribe  to  them  rules 
for  their  government ; "  and  that,  "  if  there 
did  exist  bishops  who  had  the  power  of 
the  sword,  they  derived  this  power  from 
their  quality  of  temporal  sovereigns,  and 
not  from  their  episcopal  character,  or  from 
Divine  right,  but  as  a  power  conceded  to 
them  by  kings  or  emperors." 

Notwithstanding  the  moderation  of  tone, 
especially  with  regard  to  the  doctrine  of 
consubstantiation,  in  the  confession,  the 
Zuinghans  could  not  subscribe  to  it,  and  a 
separate  confession  was  drawn  up  by  four 
imperial  cities,  in  which  they  held  a  real 
but  not  a  physical  presence  of  Christ's 
body.  (See  Confession  of  Faith,  4.)  The 
confession  of  Augsburg  became  the  basis  of 
all  subsequent  confessions. 

ILL  It  is  not  a  little  remarkable,  that 
considerable  differences,  or  various  readings, 
are  to  be  found  in  tho  pnnted  texts  of  this 
important  document,  and  that  it  is  far 
from  certain  which  copy  should  be  con- 
sidered the  authentic  edition.  The  German 
•copies  printed  in  1530,  in  quarto  and  octavo, 
and  the  Latin  edition  printed  in  quarto  in 
1531,  are  ia  request  among  bibliographical 


AUGUSTINE 


CD 


amateurs;  but  there  is  a  verbal,  and,  in 
some  instances,  a  material,  discrepancy 
among  them.  The  Wittenberg  edition,  of 
1540,  is  particularly  esteemed,  aad  has  been 
adopted  by  the  publishers  of  the  '  Sylloge 
Confessionum  Diversarum,'  printed  in  1804^ 
at  the  Clarendon  press.  [Later  editions  of 
the  Sylloge  include  also  the  form  of  1531.] 
One  of  the  most  important  of  these  various 
readings  occurs,  in  the  tenth  Article.  In 
some  of  the  editions  which  preceded  that  of 
1540,  it  is  expressed,  "  that  the  body  and 
blood  of  Christ  are  truly  present,  and 
distributed  to  those  who  partake  of  our 
Lord's  supper ; "  and  the  contrary  doctrine 
is  reprobated.  The  edition  of  1540  ex- 
presses that,  "  with  the  bread  and  wine,  the 
body  and  blood  of  Christ  are  truly  given 
to  those  who  partake  of  our  Lord's  supper." 
— Cailestinus,  Eist.  Conf.  Aug. ;  Butler's 
Conf.  Faith ;  Robertson's  Sylloge  Confes- 
sionum ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim,  iii.  138  seq. 

AUGDSTINES.  A  religious  order  in  the 
Church  of  Rome,  who  followed  St.  Augustine's 
pretended  rule,  which  was  laid  upon  them  by 
Pope  Alexander  IV.,  in  1256.  It  is  divided 
into  several  branches,  as  hermits  of  St.  Paul, 
the  Jeronymitans,  monks  of  St.  Bridget,  and 
the  Augustines  called  Chaussez,  who  go  with- 
out stockings.  This  branch  was  begun  in 
1574,  by  a  Portuguese,  and  confirmed  in  1600 
and  1602,  by  Pope  Clement  VIII.  They  were 
to  have  all  things  in  common ;  the  rich  on 
entering  the  order  were  to  give  up  all : 
nothing  was  to  be  received  without  leave 
of  the  superior  :  and  they  were  bound  down 
by  very  minute  precepts  with  regard  to 
their  conduct  and  mode  of  living. 

The  Augustine  monks  (commonly  called 
Black  Canons,  from  their  dress,)  in  England 
were  next  to  the  Benedictines  in  power  and 
wealth.  The  members  of  these  two  orders 
and  their  branches  were  called  Monks,  those 
of  the  Mendicant  orders,  as  Dominicans  and. 
Franciscans,  were  called  Friars.  (See 
Monastery.}  But  Canon  was  the  title 
more  usually  assigned  to  the  Augustines. 
This  order  was  more  numerous  and  powerful 
in  Ireland  than  the  Benedictines,  though 
inferior  to  them  in  England.  The  branches 
of  this  order  were  the  Premonstratensians 
(or  White  Canons),  the  Victorines,  and  the 
Gilbertines.  The  Arroasians  were  merely 
reformed  Augustines,  not  a  separate  branch 
of  the  order.  The  Augustines  possessed 
two  mitred  abbeys,  Waltham  and  Ciren- 
cester; one  cathedral  priory,  Carlisle;  one 
abbey,  Bristol,  afterwards  converted  into  a 
cathedral  by  Henry  VIII.,  (Hook's  Arch- 
bishops, vi.  502.)  At  Paris  they  are  known 
as  the  religious  of  St.  Genevieve,  that  abbey 
being  the  chief  house  of  the  order. 

AUGUSTINE,  or  AUSTIN,  FRIARS. 
These  are  not  to  be  confounded  with  the 


70 


AUGUSTINE 


above,  being  one  of  the  minor  Mendicant 
orders,  observing  the  rule  of  St.  Augustine. 
Fuller  says  they  first  entered  England  in 
1252 :  "  and  had  (if  not  their  first)  their 
finest  habitation  at  St.  Peter's  the  Poor, 
London,  thence  probably  taking  the  de- 
nomination of  poverty.  They  were  good 
disputants;  on  which  account  they  were 
remembered  at  Oxford  by  an  act  per- 
formed by  candidates  for  Mastership,  called 
Keeping  of  Augustines.'"  This  exercise, 
with  other  ancient  forms,  was  abolished  by 
the  University  Statute  towards  the  begin- 
ning of  the  present  centmy. 

AUGUSTINE,  ST.  First  archbishop 
of  Canterbury.  When  abbot  of  St. 
Andrew's,  Eome,  he  was  sent  by  Gregory 
the  Great  to  convert  the  English,  who  does 
not  seem  to  have  been  aware  that  a  Church 
was  already  in  existence  in  Britain.  He 
landed  in  Kent  A.D.  597,  converted  Ethel- 
bert,  the  king,  who  was  married  to  a, 
Christian  princess,  and  was  appointed  arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  being  consecrated  by 
Vergilius,  Bishop  of  Aries,  November  lli, 
597.  He  afterwards  had  a  conference  with 
the  bishops  of  the  British  Church,  and 
endeavoured  to  exert  jurisdiction  over 
them,  but  they  resisted  on  the  ground  that 
their  Church  was  not  dependent  on  the 
Church  of  Eome.  He  is  commemorated 
on  May  26  in  the  English  Calendar.    [H.] 

AUGUSTINE,  ST.,  Bishop  of  Hippo, 
Confessor,  Doctor,  commemorated  on  August 

10.  He  was  born  in  354  at  Tagaste  in 
Numidia,  and  was  piously  trained  by  his 
mother,  Monica.  Nevertheless  he  fell  into 
dissolute  habits,  and  adopted  the  views  of 
the  Manichaeans.  He  was  afterwards  con- 
verted and  baptised  by  St.  Ambrose, 
ordained,  and  after  four  years'  retirement, 
consecrated  bishop  coadjutor  of  Hippo,  to 
the  sole  charge  of  which  see  he  succeeded 
in  396.  He  was  one  of  the  four  great 
doctors  of  the  Western  Church,  and  has 
perhaps  exercised  a  greater  influence  on  the 
thought  of  subsequent  ages  than  any  other 
of  the  fathers.  The  history  of  his  con- 
version is  given  by  himself. — Corf,  of  Bt. 
Augustine.     [H.] 

AUDRY,  ST.  (See  Etheldreda.) 
AUEICULAE  CONFESSION.  (See 
Confession,  Absolution.')  The  confession  of 
sins  at  the  ear  of  the  priest.  This,  the 
Church  of  Eome  now  affirms,  is  necessary  to 
salvation.  Yet  it  is  a  "  new  doctrine  even  in 
the  Church  of  Eome,  and  was  not  esteemed 
any  part  of  the  Catholic  religion  before  the 
Council  of  Trent."     (Jer.  Taylor,  vol.  xi.  p. 

11,  Heber's  Ed.)  By  the  chapter  on  Confes- 
sion in  the  Council  of  Trent,  an  attempt  is 
made  to  invest  the  Christian  priesthood  with 
the  prerogative  of  the  Most  High,  who  is  a 
searcher  of  the  hearts,  and  a  discerner  of 


AUEICULAE 

the  thoughts ;  in  forgetfulness  of  the  very 
distinction  which  God  drew  between  him- 
self and  all  men — "man  looketh  to  the 
outward  part,  the  Lord  trieth  the  heart." 
As  Christ  has  invested  his  ministers  with 
no  power  to  do  this  of  themselves,  the 
Tridentine  Fathers  have  sought  to  supply 
what  they  must  needs  consider  a  grievous 
omission  on  his  part,  by  enjoining  all  men 
to  unlock  the  secrets  of  their  hearts  at  the 
command  of  their  priest,  and  persons  of  all 
ages  and  sexes  to  submit  not  only  to  general 
questions  as  to  a  state  of  sin  or  repentance, 
but  to  the  most  minute  and  searching 
questions  as  to  their  most  inmost  thoughts. 

The  extent  to  which  the  confessors  have 
thought  it  right  to  carry  these  examinations 
on  subjects  concerning  which  the  Apostle 
recommends  that  they  be  not  once  named 
among  Christians,  and  which  may  be  seen 
either  in  Dens'  Theology,  or  Burchard's  De- 
crees, c.  19,  Paris,  1549,  affords  a  melancholy, 
painful,  and  sickening  subject  for  contem- 
plation; especially  when  it  is  considered 
that  they  were  Christian  clergy  who  did 
this,  and  that  it  was  done  in  aid,  as  they 
supposed,  of  the  Christian  religion.  The 
effects  of  these  examinations  upon  the 
priests  themselves,  we  will  do  no  more 
than  allude  to;  he  who  may  think  it 
necessary  to  satisfy  himself  upon  the  point, 
may  consult  the  cases  contemplated  and 
provided  for  (among  others)  by  Cardinal 
Cajetan,  in  his  Opuscula,  Lugd.  1562,  p. 
114.  In  the  Bull  of  Pius  IV.,  Contra: 
solicitantes  in  confessione,  dated  Ap.  16, 
11561,  (Bullarium  Magn.  Luxemb.  1727, 
ii.  p.  48,)  and  in  a  similar  one  of  Gregory 
XV.,  dated  Aug.  30,  1622,  {Gregory  XV. 
Constit.  Rom.  1622,  p.  114,)  there  is  laid 
open  another  fearful  scene  of  danger  to 
female  confitents  from  wicked  priests, 
"  mulieres  poenitentes  ad  actus  inhonestos 
dum  earum  audiunt  confessiones  alliciendo 
et  provocando."  Against  which  flagrant 
dangers,  and  the  preparatory  steps  of  sap- 
ping and  undermining  the  mental  modesty 
of  a  young  person  by  examinations  of  par- 
ticular kinds,  it  is  vain  to  think  that  the 
bulls  of  the  bishops  of  Eome  can  afford 
any  security.  These  observations  apply 
to  the  system  of  the  Eoman  Church, 
peculiar  to  itself,  of  compelling  the  dis- 
closure of  the  most  minute  details  of  the 
most  secret  thoughts  and  actions.  As  to 
encouraging  persons  whose  minds  are  hur- 
fhened  with  the  remembrance  of  fearful 
sins,  to  ease  themselves  of  the  burthen  by 
revealing  it  to  one  at  whose  hands  they 
may  seek  guidance,  and  consolation,  and 
prayer,  it  is  a,  totally  distinct  question,  and 
nothing  but  wilful  art  will  attempt  to  con- 
found the  two. 

In  the  sixth  canon  of  the   Council  of- 


AXJEICULAK 

Trent  it  runs  thus: — "If  any  shall  deny 
that  sacramental  confession  was  instituted 
and  is  necessary  for  salvation  by  Divine 
right,  or  shall  say  that  the  custom  of  con- 
fessing secretly  to  the  priest  alone,  which 
the  Catholic  Chuich  has  always  observed 
from  the  beginning,  and  continues  to  ob- 
serve, is  foreign  to  the  institution  and 
coinmand  of  Christ,  and  is  of  human  in- 
vention, let  him  be  accursed." 

Here  sacramental  confession  is  affirmed 
to  be  of  Divine  institution,  and  auricular 
confession  likewise,  and  he  is  accursed  who 
shall  deny  it.  Yet  the  Tridentine  Fathers 
might  have  recollected  that,  in  the  Latin 
Church  as  late  as  a.d.  813,it  was  matter  of  dis- 
pute whether  there  was  need  to  confess  to  a 
priest  at  all,  as  appears  from  the  thirty-third 
canon  of  the  Council  of  CabaUlon,  which 
is  as  follows:  "Quidam  Deo  solummodo 
confiteri  debere  dicunt  peccata,  quidam 
vcro  saoerdotibus  confitenda  esse  percen- 
sent :  quod  utrumque  non  sine  magno 
fructu  intra  sanctam  fit  Ecclesiam.  Ita 
dumtaxat  ut  et  Deo,  qui  Eemissor  est  pec- 
catorum,  confiteamur  peccata  nostra,  et 
cum  David  dicamus.  Delictum  meum  cog- 
nitum  tibi  feci,  &c.,  et  secundum  institii- 
tionem  apostoli,  confiteamur  alterutrum 
peccata  nostra,  et  oremus  pro  invicem  ut 
salvemur.  Confessio  itaque  quse  Deo  fit, 
purgat  peccata,  ea  vero  quas  sacerdoti  fit, 
docet  qualiter  ipsa  purgentur  peccata,"  &c. 
(Cone.  vii.  1279.)  Was  Leo  the  Third 
asleep,  that  he  could  suffer  such  heresy  to 
be  broached  and  not  denounced?  But  it 
is  well  known,  that,  till  1215,  no  decree 
of  pope  or  council  can  be  adduced  enjoin- 
ing the  necessary  observance  of  such  a 
custom.  Then,  at  the  Council  of  Late- 
ran.  Innocent  III.  commanded  it.  As  the 
Latin  Church  affords  no  sanction  to  the 
assertion  of  the  Tridentine  Fathers,  so  is 
it  in  vain  to  look  for  it  among  the  Greeks, 
for  there,  as  Socrates  (Hist.  Kccles.  v.  19) 
and  Sozomen  (^Tiist.  Eccles.  vii.  16)  inform 
us,  the  whole  confessional  was  abolished 
by  Nectarius,  the  archbishop  of  Constan- 
tinople, in  the  fourth  century,  by  reason  of 
an  indecency  which  was  committed  on  a 
female  penitent,  when  pursuing  her  pen- 
ance; which,  certainly,  he  would  not  have 
ventured  to  have  done  had  he  deemed  it  a 
Divine  institution.  Sozomen,  in  his  account 
of  the  confessional,  says,  that  the  public 
confession  in  the  presence  of  all  tihe  people, 
which  formerly  obtained,  havnig  been 
found  grievous,  tpopriKov  i>s  cIkos,  a  well- 
bred,  silent,  and  prudent  presbyter  was  set 
in  charge  of  it ;  thus  plainly  denoting  the 
change  from  public  to  auricular  confes- 
sions. It  was  this  penitential  presbyter 
whose  office  was  abolished  by  Nectarius, 
who  acted  by   the    advice    of   Eudsemon, 


AUTOCEPHALI 


71 


(Tvy-^KopiiO'ai  fie  ckootoi/,  to)  iSito  uvviihtyri  ran/ 
fiviTTrjpiaiv  iieTi)((iv.  And  the  reason  he  as- 
signed is  one  which  the  Church  of  Rome 
would  have  done  well  to  bear  in  mind; 
ovTa>  yap  fiovios  ^X^'"  ''T''  (K<Xria-lav  to  a/3Xa(r- 
(prjprjTov.  (See  Perceval  on  lioman  Schism ; 
Hooker,  Eccl.  Pol.  book  vi. ;  Bp.  Taylor, 
Ductor  Duhit.  part  ii.  sect.  11,  vol.  xi., 
Heber's  Ed.) 

The  difference  between  the  teaching  of 
the  Church  of  Home  and  the  Church  of 
England  in  respect  to  this  practice  has 
been  summed  up  in  the  following  words: 
"  The  Church  of  Eome  regards  confession 
to  man,  as  a  means  of  grace ;  this  we 
deny ;  at  the  same  time  we  regard  it  as  a 
means  of  comfort  to  weak  minds,  and 
scrupulous  consciences,  and  to  persons  in 
difficulties,  or  in  doubt.  The  Church  of 
Eome  makes  it  the  rule,  we  the  exception. 
The  Church  of  Home  commands  it;  the 
Church  of  England  permits  it.  The  Church 
of  England,  in  accordance  with  Scripture 
and  the  Primitive  Church,  and  the  Greek 
Church,  asserts  that  confession  to  God  alone 
is  sufficient, — is  the  rule — is  the  course 
which  ought  to  be  pursued  in  all  but 
exceptional  cases ;  and  in  this  respect  to 
the  Church  of  England,  to  the  Primitive 
Church,  and  to  the  written  and  infallible 
Word  of  the  living  God,  the  Church  of 
Rome  stands  opposed." — Clmrch  and  Eer 
Ordinances,  vol.  ii.  p.  229.  Sermon  on 
Auricular  Confession,  by  W.  F.  Hook,  D.D. 

AUEORA.  The  title  of  a  Latin  metrical 
version  of  several  parts  of  the  Bible,  by 
Petrus  de  Eiga,  canon  of  Eheims,  in  the 
twelfth  century. 

AUTOCEPHALI.  AvTOKicjjaXoi,  self- 
headed,  or  independent.  A  name  origin- 
ally given  to  all  metropolitans,  as  having 
no  ecclesiastical  superior,  and  being  amen- 
able only  to  the  judgment  of  a  synod. 
After  the  division  of  the  Church  into  pa- 
triarchates, it  was  given  to  such  metro- 
politans as  preserved  their  independence, 
and  were  not  subject  to  any  patriarch — 
as  the  bishop  of  Constantia,  or  Salamis, 
in  Cyprus.  Bingham  (book  ii.  chap.  18) 
specifies  three  kinds  of  autocephali.  1.  AH 
metropolitans,  before  patriarchates  were 
established.  2.  Certain  metropolitans  after 
the  establishment  of  patriarchates,  as  those 
of  Bulgaria,  Cyprus,  and  Iberia:  and  the 
Churches  of  Britain  before  the  coming  of 
St.  Augustine :  to  which  may  be  added 
the  Church  of  Ireland,  before  its  submis- 
sion to  Eome  in  the  twelfth  century.  3, 
Bishops  immediately  subject  to  the  patri- 
arch of  the  diocese,  who  was  to  them  as  a 
metropolitan.  There  were  twenty-five  such 
subject  to  the  bishop  of  Jerusalem.  The 
immediate  suffragans  of  Eome  are  of  the 
same  class.     Bingham  considers  a   fourth 


72 


AUTO 


class  mentioned  by  Valesius  on  Euseb.  lib. 
v.,  c.  23,  as  very  doubtful;  viz.  bishops 
wholly  independent  of  all  others. 

AUTO  DA  FE  (Spanish).  An  Act  of 
Faith.  In  the  Spanish  Church  a  solemn 
day  was  wont  to  be  held  by  the  Inquisition 
for  the  execution  of  heretics,  and  the 
absolution  of  the  innocent  accused.  They 
usually  contrived  that  the  Auto  should  fall 
on  some  great  festival,  that  the  execution 
might  produce  the  more  awe ;  and  it  was 
always  on  a  Sunday.  The  executions  were 
arranged  with  the  most  cold-blooded  pomp, 
and  cruellest  barbarity.  The  victims  were 
not  merely  burnt,  but  absolutely  roasted  to 
death ;  and  the  number  so  immolated  was 
extraordinary.  In  one  year  (1481),  298 
persons  were  burnt  alive  in  Seville;  and 
2000  in  other  parts  of  Andalusia ;  and  it  is 
said  that  between  1481  and  1808,  32,000 
persons  thus  perished.  Even  if  the  num- 
bers are  exaggerated,  there  can  be  no  doubt 
that  the  working  of  the  Inquisition  in  Spain 
was  attended  by  an  amount  of  cruelty  it  is 
impossible  to  contemplate  without  horror. 
The  same  may  be  said  of  Portugal.  The 
Inquisition  was  abolished  in  Spain  in 
1835 ;  in  Portugal  in  1821.  (See  Inquisi- 
tion.)    [H.] 

AUSTRALIA.  (See  Ohurch  in  Colonies.) 

AYE  MARIA.  A  form  of  devotion  used 
in  the  Church  of  Rome,  comprising  the  salu- 
tation addressed  by  the  angel  Gabriel  to  the 
Blessed  Virgin  Mary.  (Luke  i.  28.)  The 
words  "  Ave  Maria "  are  the  first  two,  in 
Latin,  of  the  form  as  it  appears  in  the 
manuals  of  the  Roman  Church,  thus :  "  Hail 
Mary  (Ave  Maria),  fuU  of  grace,  the  Lord 
is  with  thee,  &o.  To  which  is  appended  the 
following  petition :  "  Holy  Mary,  mother  of 
God,  pray  for  us  sinnerSj  now,  and  in  the 
hour  of  our  death.  Amen."  Here  we  find, 
first,  a  misapplication  of  the  words  of  Scrip- 
ture, and  then  an  addition  to  them.  It  was  not 
used  before  the  Hours,  until  the  sixteenth 
century,  in  the  Romish  offices.  It  was  then 
introduced  into  the  Breviary  by  Cardinal 
QuignoQ.  Cardinal  Bona  admits  that  it  is 
modern. 

"I  cannot  but  observe,"  says  Bingham, 
"  that  among  all  the  short  prayers  used  by 
the  ancients  before  their  sermons,  there  is 
never  any  mention  made  of  an  Ave  Mary, 
now  so  common  in  the  practice  of  the 
Roman  Church.  Their  addresses  were  all 
to  Gt)d ;  and  the  invocation  of  the  Holy 
Virgin  for  grace  and  assistance  before 
sermons  was  a  thing  not  thought  of.  They 
who  are  most  concerned  to  prove  its  use 
can  derive  its  original  no  higher  than  the 
beginning  of  the  fifteenth  century."  But 
Mosheim  (Ecd.  Hist.  vol.  ii.  304,  Stubbs' 
Ed.)  says  that  Pope  John  XXII.  [1316-33] 
ordered  Christians  to  add  to  their  prayers 


BABYLON 

those  words  with  which  the  angel  Gabriel 
saluted  the  Virgin  Mary. 

AVOIDANCE.  Avoidance  is  where  there 
is  a  want  of  a  lawful  inoumiient  on  a  benefice, 
during  which  vacancy  the  Church  is  quasi 
viduata,  and  the  possessions  belonging  to  it 
are  in  abeyance.  There  are  many  ways  by 
which  avoidance  may  happen ;  by  death ; 
by  cession,  or  acceptance  of  a  benefice  in- 
compatible ;  by  resignation ;  by  consecra- 
tion, for  when  a  clerk  is  promoted  to  a 
bishopric,  all  his  other  preferments  are  void 
the  instant  he  is  consecrated,  and  the  right 
of  presentation  belongs  to  the  Crown,  unless 
he  has  a  dispensation  from  the  Crown  to 
hold  them  in  commendam ;  by  deprivation, 
either  first  by  sentence  declaratory  in  the 
ecclesiastical  court  for  fit  and  sufficient  causes 
allowed  by  the  common  law,  such  as  at- 
tainder of  treason  or  felony,  or  conviction  of 
other  infamous  crimes  in  the  king's  comts  ; 
for  heresy,  infidelity,  gross  immorality,  and 
the  like ;  or  secondly,  in  pursuance  of  divers 
penal  statutes,  which  declare  the  benefice 
void,  for  some  nonfeasance  or  neglect,  or  else 
some  malfeasance  or  crime;  as  for  simony; 
for  maintaining  any  doctrine  in  derogation 
of  the  king's  supremacy,  or  of  the  Thirty- 
nine  Articles,  or  of  the  Booh  of  Common 
Prayer;  for  neglecting  after  institution  to 
read  the  liturgy  and  articles  in  thfe  church, 
or  make  the  declarations  against  Popery,  or 
take  the  abjuration  oath;  for  using  any 
other  form  of  prayer  than  the  liturgy  of  the 
Church  of  England ;  or  for  absenting  him- 
self sixty  days  in  one  year  from  a  benefice 
belonging  to  a  Popish  patron,  to  which  the 
clerk  was  presented  by  either  of  the  univer- 
sities ;  in  all  which,  and  similar  cases,  the 
benefice  is  ipso  facto  void,  without  any 
formal  sentence  of  deprivation.  No  person 
can  take  any  dignity  or  benefice  in  Ireland 
until  he  has  resigned  all  his  preferments  in 
England ;  and  by  such  resignation  the  king 
is  deprived  of  the  presentation. — Stephens  on 
the  Laws  relating  to  the  Clergy,  p.  91. 

AZYMITES.  A  name  given  to  the 
Latins,  by  the  Greek  Church,  because  they 
consecrate  the  Holy  Eucharist  in  unleavened 
bread  (eV  d^v|^ols). 


BABYLON.  (1)  The  capital  of  Chaldaa, 
built  by  Nimrod.  (2)  A  mystical  city 
referred  to  by  St.  John  (Rev.  xviii.)  Lewis 
XII.,  King  of  Prance,  designated  by  this 
name  the  Romish  power:  and  it  is  the 
custom  of  certain  commentators  and  writers 
on  religious  matters  to  call  the  Roman 
Chm'ch  the  modern  Babylon.    [H.] 


BACHELOR 

BACHELOR.  The  first  degree  in  Eng- 
lish. Universities  in  arts,  divinity,  law, 
music,  or  physic.  It  was  first  introduced 
in  the  thirteenth  century  by  Pope  Gregory 
IX.,  though  it  is  now  unknown  in  Italy. 
Bachelors  of  Arts  are  not  admitted  to  that 
degree  at  Oxford,  Cambridge,  and  Dublin, 
till  after  having  studied  four,  or  at  the  least 
-three  years,  at  those  universities.  Bachelors 
of  .Divinity,  before  they  can  acquire  that 
degree  either  at  Oxford  or  Cambridge,  must 
be  of  fourteen  years'  standing  in  the  uni- 
versity. Bachelors,  as  such,  have  no  voice 
in  the  University  convocations  or  senate ; 
but  Bachelors  in  Divinity  have,  because 
they  must  necessarily  have  been  Masters  of 
Arts  previously. 

BALDACHINO,  a  kind  of  tabernacle 
or  canopy  over  the  communion  table,  which 
was  pronoxmced  illegal  in  White  v.  Bowron, 
L.  R.  4  Eoc.  207. 

BAMPTON  LECTURES.  A  course  of 
eight  sermons  founded  in  1779  by  the  llev. 
John  Bampton,  canon  of  Salisbury,  to  be 
preached  annually  before  the  University  of 
Oxford.  According  to  the  directions  in 
the  founder's  wOl,  they  are  to  be  preached 
upon  any  of  the  foUovfing  subjects  : — I'o 
confirm  and  establish  the  Christian  faith, 
and  to  confute  all  heretics  and  schismatics, 
upon  the  Divine  authority  of  the  Holy 
Scriptures ;  upon  the  authority  of  the  writ- 
ings of  the  primitive  fathers,  as  to  the  faith 
and  practice  of  the  primitive  Church ;  upon 
the  Divinity  of  our  Lord  and  Saviour 
Jesus  Christ;  upon  the  Divinity  of  the 
Holy  Ghost;  upon  the  Articles  of  the 
Christian  faith,  as  comprehended  in  the 
Apostles'  and  Nicene  Creeds.  For  the  sup- 
port of  this  lecture  he  bequeathed  his  lands 
and  estates  to  the  chancellor,  masters,  and 
scholars  of  the  University  of  Oxford  for 
ever,  upon  trust  that  the  vice-chancellor, 
for  the  time  being,  take  and  receive  all  the 
rents  and  profits  thereof;  and,  after  all 
taxes,  reparations,  and  necessary  deductions 
made,  to  pay  all  the  remainder  to  the  en- 
dowment of  these  divinity  lecture  sermons. 
He  also  directs  in  his  will,  that  the  lectmer 
should  be  chosen  by  the  heads  of  colleges 
only,  that  no  person  shall  be  qualified  to 
preach  these  lectures,  unless  he  have  taken 
the  degree  of  Master  of  Arts,  at  least,  in 
one  of  the  two  Universities  of  Oxford  or 
Cambridge,  and  that  the  same  person  shall 
never  preach  the  same  sermon  twice. 
Thirty  copies  of  the  lectures  are  always 
to  be  printed,  and  issued  to  the  Bodleian 
Library,  vice-chancellor,  and  others,  before 
the  preacher  is  paid,  the  cost  to  come  out  of 
the  revenue,  which  in  1779  amounted  to 
£120,  but  has  since  nearly  doubled.  A 
number  of  excellent  sermons  preached  at 
this  lecture  are  now  before  the  public. 


BANNER 


73 


BAND  or  BANDS.  Two  oblong  pieces  of 
cambric  or  linen,  four  to  nine  inches  long, 
and  two  or  three  wide,  joined  together,  and 
worn  under  the  chin.  This  is  said  by  some  to 
be  a  relic  of  the  amice;  but  it  is  not  an 
exclusively  clerical  vestment,  being  part  of 
the  fuU  dress  of  the  bar  and  of  the  uni- 
versities, and  of  other  bodies  in  which  a 
more  ancient  habit  is  retained,  as  in  some 
schools  of  old  foundation.     [H.] 

BANGORIAN  CONTROVERSY.  This 
was  a  celebrated  controversy  within  the 
Church  of  England  in  the  reign  of  George  I., 
and  received  its  name  from  Hoadly,  who, 
although  bishop  of  Bangor,  was  little  else 
than  a  Socinian  heretic.  Hoadly  published 
"  A  Preservative  against  the  Principles  and 
Practice  of  the  Non-jurors,"  and  soon  after, 
a  sermon,  which  the  king  had  ordered  to  be 
printed,  entitled,  "  The  Nature  of  the  King- 
dom of  Christ."  This  discourse  is  a  very 
confused  production;  nor,  except  in  the 
bitterness  of  its  spirit,  is  it  easy,  amidst 
the  author's  "  periods  of  a  mile,"  to  discover 
his  precise  aim.  (Hoadley's  Works,  vol.  ii, 
1773.)  To  the  perplexed  arguments  of 
Bishop  Hoadly,  Dr.  Snape  and  Dr.  Sherlock 
%vrote  replies ;  and  a  committee  of  convoca- 
tion passed  a  censure  upon  the  discourse  in 
1717.  An  order  from  government  arrested 
the  proceedings  of  the  convocation.  Snape 
and  Sherlock  were  removed  from  their  office 
of  chaplains  to  the  king ;  and  the  convoca- 
tion was  not  permitted  to  assemble  again  for 
the  transaction  of  business  until  its  revival 
in  the  year  1852.  But  the  exertion  of 
power  on  the  part  of  the  govermnent  was 
unable  to  silence  those  who  were  deter- 
mined, at  any  sacrifice,  to  maintain  God's 
truth.  This  controversy  continued  to  em- 
ploy the  press  for  many  years,  until  those 
who  held  Socinian  views  were  entirely 
silenced  by  the  force  of  argument.  Of  the 
works  produced  by  the  Bangorian  Contro- 
versy, perhaps  the  most  important  is  Law's 
Letters  to  Eoadly,  which  were  reprinted  in 
Tlie  Scholar  Armed,  and  have  since  been 
republished,  1812.  Law's  Letters  have  never 
been  answered,  and  may  indeed  be  regarded 
as  unanswerable.  (See  Life  and  Opinions 
of  William  Law,  by  J.  H.  Overton ;  and 
English  Church  in  the  Eighteenth  Century, 
by  Abbey  and  Overton.) 

BANNER.  In  the  chapels  of  orders  of 
knighthood,  as  in  St.  George's  Chapel, 
Windsor,  the  chapel  of  the  order  of  the 
Garter ;  in  Henry  VII.'s  chapel,  at  West- 
minster, the  chapel  of  the  order  of  the 
Bath;  and  in  St.  Patrick's  Cathedral,  the 
chapel  of  the  order  of  St.  Patrick;  the 
banner  of  each  knight,  i.e.  a  little  square 
flag  bearing  his  arms,  is  suspended,  at  his 
installation,  over  his  appropriate  stall.  The 
installation  of  a  knight  is  a  religious  cere- 


71 


BANNS 


mony;  hence  the  propriety  of  this  act.  The 
same  decorations  formerly  existed  in  the 
chapel  of  Holyrood  House,  the  chapel  of  the 
order  of  the  Thistle. 

BANNS  OF  MAEBIAGE.  "  Bann  " 
comes  from  a  barbarous  Latin  word  which 
signifies  to  put  out  an  edict  or  proclama- 
tion. "  Matrimonial  banns  "  are  such  pro- 
clamations as  are  solemnly  made  in  the 
church,  or  in  some  other  lawful  congrega- 
tion of  men,  in  order  to  the  solemnization 
of  matrimony. 

Before  any  can  be  canonioally  married, 
except  by  a  licence  from  the  bishop's  court, 
and  now  by  a  registrar  of  births,  deaths, 
and  marriages,  the  banns  are  directed  to  be 
published  in  the  church;  and  this  pro- 
clamation should  be  made  on  three  days, 
in  the  churches  of  that  place  where  the 
parties,  willing  to  contract  marriage,  dwell. 
This  rule  is  principally  to  be  observed  when 
the  said  parties  are  of  different  parishes; 
for  the  care  of  the  Church  to  prevent  clan- 
destine marriages  is  as  old  as  Christianity 
itself:  and  the  design  of  the  Church  is  to 
be  satisfied  whether  there  be  any  "just 
cause  or  impediment "  why  the  persons  so 
asked  "should  not  be  joined  together  in 
holy  matrimony." 

The  following  are  the  regulations  under 
which  the  Church  of  England  now  acts  on 
this  subject : — ■ 

No  minister  shall  be  obliged  to  publish 
the  banns  of  matrimony  between  any  per- 
sons whatsoever,  unless  they  shall,  seven 
days  at  least  before  the  time  required  for 
the  first  publication,  deliver  or  cause  to  be 
delivered  to  him  a  notice  in  writing  of 
their  true  Christian  and  surnames,  and  of 
the  houses  of  their  respective  abodes  within 
such  parish,  chapelry,  or  extra-parochial 
place,  where  the  tjanns  are  to  be  published, 
and  of  the  time  during  which  they  have 
inhabited  or  lodged  in  such  houses  respec- 
tively. This  was  first  enacted  by  26  Geo.  II. 
c.  23,  commonly  called  Lord  Hardwicke's 
Marriage  Act  for  preventing  Clandestine 
Marriages,  which  is  superseded  and  partly 
re-enacted  by  4  Geo.  IV.  c.  76.  By  both 
Acts  it  is  enacted,  that  where  the  persons 
to  be  married  shall  dwell  in  divers  parishes 
or  chapeWes,  the  banns  shall  be  pubUshed 
in  the  church  or  chapel  belonging  to  such 
parish  or  chapelry  wherein  each  of  the  said 
persons  shall  dwell.  And  where  both  or 
either  of  the  persons  to  be  married  shall 
dwell  in  any  extra-parochial  place  (having 
no  church  or  chapel  wherein  banns  have 
been  usually  published),  then  the  banns 
shall  be  published  in  the  parish  church  or 
chapel  belonging  to  some  parish  or  chapelry 
adjoining  to  such  extra-parochial  place. 
And  the  said  banns  shall  be  published  upon 
three  Sundays  preceding  the  solemnization 


BANNS 

of  marriage  during  the  time  of  morning 
service,  or  of  the  evening  service,  if  there 
be  no  morning  service  in  such  church  or 
chapel  on  that  Sunday,  immediately  after 
the  second  lesson. 

It  was  for  some  years  assumed  that 
this  last  clause  repealed  the  old  rubric  for 
publication  of  banns  after  the  Nicene 
Creed  in  Morning  Service,  and  the  Uni- 
versities' and  Queen's  printers  took  upon 
themselves  to  omit  it,  and  print  that  section 
of  the  Act  as  a  new  rubric  before  the  Mar- 
riage Service,  in  ignorance  of  the  rule  of 
law  that  statutes  are  not  repealed  inferen- 
tially  unless  the  later  is  absolutely  incon- 
sistent with  the  earlier.  Baron  Alderson 
pointed  out  this  mistake  in  a  trial  of  Beff. 
V.  Benson,  in  1866,  which  arose  as  usual 
from  the  bad  framing  of  the  clause  in  the 
Act  of  Geo.  IV.,  which  only  meant  to 
provide  for  banns  in  the  evening,  when 
there  is  no  morning  service.  The  old  rubnc 
has  not  yet  been  reprinted,  as  it  ought  to 
be,  with  the  additional  provision  for  Even- 
ing Service ;  but  the  old  practice  is  getting 
generally  restored. 

By  6  &  7  Will.  IV.  c.  85,  and  1  Vict.  c. 
22,  the  bishop,  with  consent  of  patron  and 
incumbent,  may  licence  other  chapels  in  the 
parish  for  marriages  and  banns,  and  the 
parties  may  be  married  either  there  or  in 
the  parish  church.  But  that  option  ceases 
as  soon  as  such  chapels  have  a  parish  as- 
signed to  them,  which  there\ipon  become 
separate  parishes  for  all  ecclesiastical  pur- 
poses, which  does  not,  however,  destroy  the 
right  of  voting  for  churchwardens  of  the 
old  parish.  (Beg.  v.  Stephens,  3  B.  &  S. 
333  ;  32  L.  J.,  Q.  B.,  70.) 

By  sect.  8  of  the  Act  of  4  Geo.  IV. 
c.  76,  clergymen  are  freed  from  ecclesias- 
tical censures  for  marrying  minors  whose 
banns  have  been  duly  published,  and 
not  forbidden  by  parents  or  guardians, 
over-riding  the  62nd  Canon.  Such  for- 
bidding makes  the  banns  void.  They  also 
become  void  by  ss.  2  and  9,  if  the  marriage 
is  not  celebrated  in  one  of  the  churches 
where  the  banns  where  published  within 
three  (calendar)  months  after  publication. 
When  churches  are  under  repair,  so  that 
they  cannot  be  used,  the  banns  may  be 
published  in  any  adjoining  church  or  build- 
ing licensed  for  that  purpose  by  the  bishop, 
under  that  Act,  and  5  Geo.  FV.  c.  32. 

The  Act  of  1823  contains  also  this  Dra- 
conian clause  (21),  unrepealed  yet,  that 
any  person  who  shall  knowingly  celebrate  a 
marriage  without  due  publication  of  banns 
or  a  licence  (which  may  include  a  mistake 
about  the  law  by  himself),  or  at  any  time 
before  8  a.m.  and  after  12  (now  defined  to  be 
Greenwich  time  only),  or  falsely  pretending 
to  be  in  holy  orders,  shall  be  transported 


BAPTISM 

for  fourteen  years  for  felony.  But  it  is 
only  felony,  with  no  prescribed  iDunishment, 
to  marry  people  without  the  due  formalities 
in  buildings  licensed  for  civil  or  registrars' 
marriages.  So  a  Dissenting  minister  or 
registrar  may  be  imprisoned  for  a  few 
days  for  the  same  offence  for  which  a 
clergyman  Tnust  be  transported  for  fourteen 
years.  The  canons  62  and  63  relating  to 
these  matters  being  now  superseded  by  the 
Acts,  it  is  quite  unnecessary  to  quote  them. 
(See  Marriage.') 

Buhric.  And  the  curate  shall  say  after 
the  accustomed  manner: — "I  publish  the 

banns  of  marriage  between  M.  of , 

and  N.  of  .     If  any  of  you  know 

cause  or  just  impediment  why  these  two 
persons  should  not  be  joined  together  in 
holy  matrimony,  ye  are  to  declare  it. 
This  is  the  first  (second,  or  third)  time  of 
asking." 

And  in  case  the  parents  or  guardians,  or 
one  of  them,  of  either  of  the  parties,  who 
shall  be  under  the  age  of  twenty-one  years, 
shall  openly  and  publicly  declare,  or  cause 
to  be  declared,  in  the  church  or  chapel  where 
the  banns  shall  be  so  published,  at  the  time 
of  such  publication,  his  dissent  to  such 
marriage,  such  publication,  of  banns  shall 
be  void.     (26  George  II.  c.  3,  s.  3.) 

Rubric.  And  where  the  parties  dwell 
in  divers  parishes,  the  curate  of  one  parish 
shall  not  solemnize  marriage  between  them, 
without  a  certificate  of  the  banns  being 
thrice  asked,  from  the  curate  of  the  other 
parish. 

The  statute  6  &  7  Will.  IV.  c.  85,  s.  1, 
enacts  also  that  where,  by  any  law  or  canon 
in  force  before  the  passing  of  this  act,  it  is 
provided  that  any  "marriage  may  be  so- 
lenmized  after  publication  of  banns,  such 
marriage  may  be  solemnized,  in  like  man- 
ner, on  production  of  the  registrar's  certifi- 
cate as  hereinafter  provided."     [G.] 

BAPTISM.  (BdwTfij',  to  dip,  and  fiair- 
ri^fiv,  to  dip  repeatedly,  or  thoroughly ;  to 
bathe.) 

Baptism  is  one  of  the  two  sacraments, 
which,  according  to  the  Catechism,  "are 
generally  necessary  to  salvation."  Our 
blessed  Saviour  says  "  that  except  a  man 
be  bom  again  he  cannot  see  the  kingdom 
of  God  "  (John  iii.  3) ;  and  in  explanation 
of  his  meaning  he  adds,  "  Verily,  verily,  I 
say  unto  thee,  except  a  man  be  born  of 
water  and  of  the  Spirit,  he  cannot  enter 
into  the  kingdom  of  God "  (ver.  5).  Upon 
this  the  Church  remarks  in  the  Baptis- 
mal Service  for  Adults :  "  Beloved,  ye 
hear  in  this  Gospel  the  express  words  of 
our  Saviour  Christ,  that,  except  a  man 
be  bom  of  water  and  of  the  Spirit,  he 
cannot  enter  into  the  kingdom  of  God : 
whereby  ye   may   perceive   the   great   ne- 


BAPTISM 


75 


cessity  of  this  sacrament  where  it  may  be 
had.  Likewise  immediately  before  his 
ascension  into  heaven,  as  we  read  in  the 
last  chapter  of  St.  Mark's  Gospel,  he  gave 
command  to  his  disciples,  saying,  '  Go  ye 
into  all  the  world,  and  preach  the  Gospel 
to  every  creature.  He  that  believeth  and 
is  baptized  shall  be  saved;  but  he  that  be- 
lieveth not  shall  be  damned.'  "Which  also 
showeth  unto  us  the  great  benefit  we  reap 
thereby.  For  which  cause,  St.  Peter  the 
Apostle,  when,  upon  his  first  preaching  of 
this  Gospel,  many  were  pricked  at  the 
heart,  and  said  unto  him  and  the  rest  of 
the  Apostles,  '  Men  and  brethren,  what  shall 
we  do  ? '  replied  and  said  unto  them,  '  Re- 
pent, and  be  baptized  every  one  of  you  for 
the  remission  of  sins,  and  ye  shall  receive 
the  gift  of  the  Holy  Ghost.'  The  same 
Apostle  testifieth  in  another  place,  'even 
baptism  doth  also  now  save  us,  not  the 
putting  away  of  the  filth  of  the  flesh,  but 
the  answer  of  a  good  conscience  towards 
God,  by  the  resurrection  of  Jesus  Christ.' " 
The  Church  states  in  the  Catechism,  that 
a  sacrament,  as  baptism  is,  hath  two 
parts,  the  outward  visible  sign,  and  the 
inward  spiritual  grace;  that  the  outward 
visible  sign  or  form  in  baptism  is  water, 
wherein  the  person  is  baptized  in  the  name 
of  the  Father,  and  of  the  Son,  and  of  the 
Holy  Ghost;  and  that  the  inward  and 
spiritual  grace,  which  through  the  means  of 
baptism  we  receive,  is  a  death  unto  sin,  and 
a  new  birth  unto  righteousness ;  for  being 
by  nature  born  in  sin  and  the  children  of 
wrath,  we  are  hereby,  i.e.  by  baptism, 
made  children  of  grace.  Therefore  the 
Church,  as  soon  as  ever  a  child  is  baptized, 
directs  the  minister  to  say,  "Seeing  now, 
dearly  beloved  brethren,  that  this  child  is 
regenerate  and  grafted  into  the  body  of 
Christ's  Church,  let  us  give  thanks  unto 
Almighty  God  for  these  benefits,  and  with 
one  accord  make  our  prayers  unto  him,  that 
this  child  may  lead  the  rest  of  his  Ufe 
according  to  this  begiiming."  The  Church 
here  first  declares  that  grace  has  been 
given,  even  the  grace  of  regeneration,  and 
then  implies  that  the  grace,  if  not  used, 
may  be  lost.  On  this  subject  more  wiU  be 
said  in  the  article  on  Regeneration.  See 
also  Infant  Baptism. 

I.  In  the  primitive  Christian  Church  the 
office  of  baptizing  wasvested  principally  in  the 
bishops  and  priests,  or  pastors  of  the  respec- 
tive parishes ;  hut,  with  the  consent  of  the 
bishop,  it  was  allowed  to  the  deacons,  and  in 
cases  of  necessity  even  to  laymen,  to  baptize ; 
but  never,  under  any  necessity  whatever,  was 
it  permitted  to  women  to  perform  this 
ofSce.  Nor  was  it  enough  that  baptism 
was  conferred  by  a  person  called  to  the 
ministry,  unless  he  was   also  orthodox  in 


76  BAPTISM 

the  faith.  This  became  matter  of  great  ex- 
citement in  the  Chiirch ;  and  hence  arose  the 
famous  controversy  between  Cyprian  and 
Stephen,  bishop  of  Kome,  concerning  the 
rebaptizing  those  who  had  been  baptized 
by  heretics,  Cyprian  asserting  that  they 
ought  to  be  rebaptized,  and  Stephen  main- 
taining the  contrary  opinion. 

The  persons  baptized  were  either  infants 
or  adults.  To  prove  that  infants  were  ad- 
mitted to  the  sacrament  of  baptism,  we 
need  only  use  this  argument.  None  were 
admitted  to  the  Eucharist  till  they  had  re- 
ceived baptism:  but  in  the  primitive 
•  Church  children  received  the  sacrament  of 
the  Lord's  supper,  as  appears  from  what 
Cyprian  relates  concerning  a  sucking  child, 
who  so  violently  refused  to  taste  the  sacra- 
mental wine,  that  the  deacon  was  obliged 
forcibly  to  open  her  lips  and  pour  it  down 
her  throat.  Origen  writes,  that  children 
are  baptized,  "  for  the  purging  away  of  the 
natural  filth  and  original  impurity  inher- 
ent in  them.  We  might  add  the  testi- 
monies of  Irenajus  and  Cyprian;  but  it 
will  be  sufficient  to  mention  the  deter- 
mination of  an  African  synod,  held  a.d. 
254,  at  which  were  present  sixty-six  bishops. 
The  occasion  of  it  was  this.  A  certain 
bishop,  called  Fidus,  had  some  scruples 
concerning  the  time  of  baptizing  infants, 
whether  it  ought  to  be  done  on  the  second 
or  third  day  alter  their  birth,  or  not  before 
the  eighth  day,  as  was  observed  with  re- 
spect to  circumcision  under  the  Jewish 
dispensation.  His  scruples  were  proposed 
to  this  synod,  who  unanimously  decreed, 
that  the  baptism  of  children  was  not  to  be 
deferred  so  long,  but  that  the  grace  of  God, 
or  baptism,  should  be  given  unto  all,  and 
most  especially  unto  infants. — Justin  Mar- 
tyr, Second  Apology  ;  De  Lapsis,  §  20 ;  In 
Lucam,  Hom.  xiv. ;  Apud  Cyprian.  Bpist. 
lix.  §  2-4 ;  TertuU.  de  Baptismo,  c.  19. 

As  for  the  time,  or  season,  at  which 
baptism  was  usually  administered,  we  find 
it  to  have  been  restrained  to  the  two 
solemn  festivals  of  the  year,  Easter  and 
Whitsuntide:  at  Easter,  in  memory  of 
Christ's  death  and  resurrection,  corre- 
spondent to  which  are  the  two  parts  of  the 
Christian  life,  represented  and  shadowed  out 
in  baptism,  dying  unto  sin,  and  rising  again 
unto  newness  of  life  ;  and  at  Whitsuntide, 
in  memory  of  the  Holy  Ghost  being  shed 
upon  the  Apostles,  the  same,  in  some 
measure,  being  represented  and  conveyed  in 
baptism.  It  is  to  be  observed,  that  these 
stated  returns  of  the  time  of  baptism  related 
only  to  persons  in  health:  in  other  cases, 
such  as  sickness,  or  any  pressing  necessity, 
the  time  of  baptism  was  regulated  by  oc- 
casion and  opportunity. 

The  place  of  baptism  was   at   first  un- 


BAPTISM 

limited ;  being  some  pond  or  lake,  some 
spring  or  river,  but  always  as  near  as  pos- 
sible to  the  place  of  public  worship.  After- 
wards they  had  their  baptisteries,  or  fonts, 
built  at  first  near  the  church,  then  in  the 
church-porch,  and  at  last  in  the  church  itself. 
There  were  many  in  those  days  who  were 
desirous  to  be  baptized  in  the  river  Jordan, 
out  of  reverence  to  the  place  where  our 
Saviour  himself  had  been  baptized. 

The  person  to  be  baptized,  if  an  adult, 
was  first  examined  by  the  bishop,  or  ofSci- 
ating  priest,  who  put  some  questions  to 
him ;  as,  first,  whether  he  abjured  the 
devil  and  all  his  works ;  secondly,  whether 
he  gave  a  firm  assent  to  all  the  articles  of 
the  Christian  faith :  to  both  which  he  an- 
swered in  the  affirmative.  Concerning 
these  baptismal  questions,  Dionysius  Alex- 
andrinus,  in  his  letter  to  Xystus,  bishop  of 
Rome,  speaks  of  a  certain  scrupulous  per- 
son in  his  church,  who,  being  present  at 
baptism,  was  exceedingly  troubled,  when 
he  heard  the  questions  and  answers  of 
those  who  were  baptised.  If  the  person 
to  be  baptised  was  an  infant,  these  inter- 
rogatories were  answered  by  his  sponsores, 
or  godfathers.  Whether  the  use  of  spon- 
sors was  as  old  as  the  Apostles'  days,  is  un- 
certain; perhaps  it  was  not,  since  Justin 
Martyr,  speaking  of  the  method  and  form 
of  baptism,  does  not  say  a  word  of  them. — 
Tertull.  de  Coron.  Milit. ;  Cyprian,  Epist. 
vn.  §  5  ;  Justin  Martyr,  Apolog.  2 ;  Apud 
Euseb.  lib.  vii.  c.  9 ;  Apolog.  2. 

After  the  questions  and  answers,  fol- 
lowed exorcism,  the  manner  and  end  of 
which  was  this.  The  minister  laid  his 
hands  on  the  person's  head,  and  breathed 
in  his  face,  implying  thereby  the  driving 
away,  or  expelling,  of  the  devil  from  him, 
and  preparing  him  for  baptism,  by  which 
the  good  and  holy  Spirit  was  to  be  con- 
ferred upon  him. 

After  exorcism  followed  baptism  itself: 
and  first  the  minister,  by  prayer,  conse- 
crated the  water  for  that  use.  Tertullian 
says,  "  any  waters  may  be  applied  to  that 
use ;  but  then  God  must  be  first  invo- 
cated,  and  then  the  Holy  Ghost  presently 
comes  down  from  Heaven,  and  moves  iipon 
them,  and  sanctifies  them."  The  water 
being  consecrated,  the  person  was  bap- 
tized "  in  the  name  of  the  Father,  and  of 
the  Son  and  of  the  Holy  Ghost ; "  by 
which  "  dedication  of  him  to  the  blessed 
Trinity,  the  person"  (says  Clemens  Alex- 
andrinus)  is  "delivered  from  the  corrupt 
trinity,  the  devil,  the  world,  and  the  flesh." 
— Tertull.  de  Baptismo ;  Justin  Martyr, 
Apolog.  2. 

In  performing  the  ceremony  of  baptism, 
the  usual  custom  was  to  immerse  and  dip 
the  whole  body.     Thus  St.  Barnabas,  de- 


BAPTISM 

scribing  a  Ijaptized  person,  says,  "  We  go 
down  into  the  water  full  of  sia  and  filth, 
but  we  ascend  bearing  fruit  in  our  hearts." 
And  that  all  occasions  of  scandal  and  im- 
modesty might  be  prevented  in  so  sacred 
an  action,  the  men  and  women  were  bap- 
tized in  distinct  apartments ;  the  women 
having  deaconesses  to  undress  and  dress 
them.  Then  followed  the  unction,  by 
which  (says  St.  Cyril)  was  signified  that 
they  were  now  cut  off  from  the  wild  olive, 
and  were  ingrafted  into  Christ,  the  true 
olive-tree ;  or  else  to  show  that  they  were 
now  to  be  champions  for  the  gospel,  and 
were  anointed  thereto,  as  the  old  Athletae 
were  against  their  solemn  games.  With 
this  anointing  was  joined  the  sign  of  the 
cross,  made  upon  the  forehead  of  the  person 
baptized ;  which  being  done,  he  had  a  white 
garment  given  him,  to  denote  his  being 
washed  from  the  defilements  of  sin,  or  in 
allusion  to  the  words  of  the  Apostle,  "  as 
many  as  are  baptized  into  Christ  have  put 
on  Christ."  From  this  custom  some 
suppose  that  the  feast  of  Pentecost,  which 
was  one  of  the  annual  seasons  of  baptism, 
came  to  be  called  Whit-Sunday,  i.e.  White- 
Sunday.  But  this  is  probably  not  the  true 
derivation.  (See  Wliit-. Sunday.)  This 
garment  was  afterwards  laid  up  in  the 
church,  that  it  might  be  an  evidence 
against  such  persons  as  violated  or  denied 
that  faith  which  they  had  owned  in 
baptism.  Of  this  we  have  a  remarkable 
instance  under  the  Arian  persecution  in 
Africa.  Elpidophorus,  a  citizen  of  Car- 
thage, had  lived  a  long  time  in  the 
communion  of  the  Cliurch,  but,  aposta- 
tizing afterwards  to  the  Arians,  became  a 
most  bitter  and  implacable  persecutor  of 
the  orthodox.  Among  several  whom  he 
sentenced  to  the  rack,  was  one  Miritas,  a 
venerable  old  deacon,  who,  being  ready  to 
be  put  upon  the  rack,  pulled  out  the  white 
garment  with  which  Elpidophorus  had 
been  clothed  at  his  baptism,  and,  with 
tears  in  his  eyes,  thus  addressed  him  before 
all  the  people.  "  These,  Elpidophorus,  thou 
minister  of  error,  these  are  the  garments  that 
shall  accuse  thee,  when  thou  shalt  appear 
before  the  majesty  of  the  Great  Judge; 
these  are  they  which  girt  thee  when  thou 
earnest  pure  out  of  the  holy  font ;  and  these 
are  they  which  shall  bitterly  pursue  thee, 
when  thou  shalt  be  cast  into  the  place  of 
flames;  because  thou  hast  clothed  thyself 
with  erasing  as  with  a  garment,  and  hast 
cast  off  the  sacred  obligation  of  thy  bap- 
tism."— Epist.  Oathol.  §  9 ;  Cave's  Pri- 
mitive Christianity,  pt.  i.  c.  10;  Epiph. 
Exres.  79 ;  Ambrose,  de  Sacr.  lib.  i.  c.  21 ; 
Gal.  iii.  27;  Victor.  Utic.  de  Fersecut. 
Vandal,  lib.  iii. 
But  though   immersion  was   the  usual 


BAPTISSI 


77 


practice,  yet  sprinkling  was  in  some  cases 
allowed,  as  in  clinic  baptism,  or  the  baptism 
of  such  persons  as  lay  sick  in  bed.  It  is 
true,  this  kind  of  baptism  was  not  esteemed 
so  perfect  and  effectual  as  that  by  im- 
mersion or  dippiing;  for  which  reason,  in 
some  Churches,  none  were  advanced  to  the 
order  of  the  priesthood,  who  had  been 
so  baptized;  an  instance  of  which  we  have 
in  Novatian,  whose  ordination  was  opposed 
by  all  the  clergy  upon  that  account;  though 
afterward,  at  the  entreaties  of  the  bishop, 
they  consented  to  it.  Notwithstanding 
which  general  opinion,  Cyprian,  in  a  set 
discourse  on  this  subject,  declares  that  he 
thought  this  baptism  to  be  as  perfect  and 
valid  as  that  performed  more  solemnly  by 
immersion.  —  Epist.  Cornel,  ad  Fahimn 
Antioch.  apvd  Euseb.  lib.  vi.  cap.  43.  Epist. 
Ixxvi.  §  9.  Apolog.  2. 

When  baptism  was  performed,  the  per- 
son baptized,  according  to  Justin  Martyr, 
"  was  received  into  the  number  of  the  faith- 
ful, who  then  sent  up  their  public  prayers 
to  God,  for  all  men,  for  themselves,  and  for 
those  who  had  been  baptized." 

Though  baptism  was  esteemed  by  the 
Church  as  a  Divine  and  heavenly  institu- 
tion, yet  there  wanted  not  sects,  in  the 
earliest  ages,  who  either  rejected  it  in  whole 
or  in  part,  or  greatly  corrupted  it.  (See 
Ascodrutes ;  Archontics ;  Manicheans  ;  Pau- 
liciaiis;  Seleucians.) — Bingham,  Orig.Eccles. 
bk.  X.  cap.  2,  §  1 ;  Epiph.  Eaires.  40 ; 
Theod.  Hxr.  Fob.  1.  i.  cap.  11 ;  August,  de 
Hmres.  cap.  59 ;  Philastr.  de  Hssres.  Prx- 
destinat.  Hxres.  40 ;  Euthym.  Panoplia,  par. 
ii.  tit.  21. 

Though  the  ancient  Church  considered 
baptism  as  indispensably  necessary  to  sal- 
vation, it  was  always  with  this  restriction, 
"  provided  it  could  be  had :"  in  extraordinary, 
cases,  wherein  baptism  could  not  be  hard 
though  men  were  desirous  of  it,  they 
made  several  exceptions  in  behalf  of  other 
things,  which  in  such  circumstances  were 
thought  sufficient  to  sujjply  the  want  of 
it.  (Bingham,  bk.  x.  11,  §§  19,  20.)  The 
chief  of  these  accepted  cases  was  martyrdom^ 
which  usually  goes  by  the  name  of  second 
baptism,  or  baptism  in  men's  own  blood,  in 
the  writings  of  the  ancients.  (Cyprian. 
Ep.  Ixiii.  ad  Julian.')  This  baptism,  they 
suppose,  our  Lord  spoke  of,  when  he  said, 
"  I  have  another  baptism  to  be  baptized 
with,"  alluding  to  his  own  future  martyr- 
dom on  the  cross.  In  the  Acts  of  the 
Martyrdom  of  Perpetua,  there  is  mention 
of  one  Saturus,  a  catechumen,  who,  being 
thrown  to  a  leopard,  was,  by  the  first  bite 
of  the  wild  beast,  so  bathed  in  blood, 
that  the  people,  in  derision  of  the  Christian 
doctrine  of  martyrdom,  cried  out  salvum 
lotum,  salvum  lotum,  baptized  and  saved. 


78  BAPTISM 

■baptized  and  saved.  (Bingham,  ibid.  §  24.) 
But  these  exceptions  and  allowances  were 
with  respect  to  adult  persons  only,  who  could 
make  some  compensation,  by  acts  of  faith 
and  repentance,  for  the  want  of  the  external 
ceremony  of  baptism.  But,  as  to  infants 
who  died  without  baptism,  the  case  was 
thought  more  difficult,  because  they  were 
destitute  both  of  "  the  outward  visible  sign 
and  the  inward  spiritual  grace  of  baptism." 
Upon  which  account  they  who  spoke  the 
most  favourably  of  their  case,  would  only 
venture  to  assign  them  a  middle  state, 
neither  in  heaven  nor  hell. — Greg.  Naz. 
Orat.  40 ;  Sever.  Catena  in  Jolian.  iii. 

For  the  rest,  the  rite  of  baptism  was 
esteemed  as  the  most  universal  absolution 
and  grand  indulgence  of  the  ministry  of 
the  Church ;  as  conveying  a  general  pardon 
of  sin  to  every  true  member  of  Christ ; 
and  as  the  key  of  the  sacraments,  that 
opens  the  gate  of  the  kingdom  of  heaven. 
— ^Bingham,  bk.  xix.  c.  i.  §  9. 

Baptism  is  defined  by  the  Church  of  Rome 
(see  Alet's  EituaT)  to  be  "a  sacrament, 
instituted  by  our  Saviour,  to  wash  away 
original  sin,  and  all  those  we  may  have 
committed ;  to  communicate  to  mankind 
the  spiritual  regeneration,  and  the  grace 
of  Christ  Jesus ;  and  to  tmite  them  to 
Mm,  as  the  living  members  to  the  head." 

The  Eoman  Church  allows  midwives,  in 
cases  of  danger,  to  baptize  a  child  before  it 
is  come  entirely  out  of  its  mother's  womb : 
where  it  is  to  be  observed,  that  some  part 
of  the  body  of  the  child  must  appear  before 
it  can  be  baptized,  and  that  it  is  baptized 
on  the  part  which  first  appears:  if  it  be 
the  head  it  is  not  necessary  to  re-baptize 
the  child;  but  if  only  a  foot  or  hand  ap- 
pears, it  is  necessary  to  repeat  baptism. 
A  still-born  child,  thus  baptized,  may  be 
buried  in  consecrated  ground.  A  monster, 
or  creature  that  has  not  the  human  form, 
must  not  be  baptized :  if  it  be  doubtful 
whether  it  be  a  human  creature  or  not,  it 
is  baptized  conditionally  thus,  "If  thou 
art  a  man,  I  baptize  thee,"  &c. 

The  Greek  Church  differs  from  the 
Eoman,  as  to  the  rite  of  baptism,  chiefly, 
in  performing  it  by  immersion,  or  plunging 
the  infant  all  over  in  the  water,  which  the 
relations  of  the  child  take  care  to  have 
warmed,  and  throw  into  it  a  collection  of 
the  most  odoriferous  flowers. — Bycaut's 
State  of  the  Oreelc  Church. 

II.  The  Church  of  England  (Article 
xxvii.)  defines  baptism  to  be,  "  not  only  a 
sign  of  profession,  and  mark  of  difference, 
whereby  Christian  men  are  discerned  from 
others  that  be  not  christened ;  but  it  is  also 
a  sign  of  regeneration,  or  new  birth,  where- 
by, as  hy  an  instrument,  they  that  receive 
baptism  rightly  are  grafted  into  the  Church : 


BAPTISM 

the  promises  of  the  forgiveness  of  sin,  of 
our  adoption  to  be  the  sons  of  God,  by  the 
Holy  Ghost,  are  visibly  signed  and  sealed, 
faith  is  confirmed,  and  grace  increased,  by 
virtue  of  prayer  to  God."  It  is  added, 
"that  the  baptism  of  young  children  is 
in  any  wise  to  be  retained  in  the  Church, 
as  most  agreeable  with  the  institution  of 
Christ." 

In  the  rubric  (see  Office  for  Ministration 
of  Public  Baptism)  the  Chiu-ch  prescribes, 
that  baptism  be  administered  only  on 
Sundays  and  holy  days,  except  in  cases  of 
necessity.  She  requires  sponsors  for  in- 
fants ;  for  every  male  child  two  godfathers 
and  one  godmother ;  and  for  every  female 
two  godmothers  and  one  godfather.  We 
find  this  provision  made  by  a  constitu- 
tion of  Edmund,  archbishop  of  Canter- 
bury, A.D.  1236 ;  and  in  a  synod  held  at 
Worcester  a.d.  1240.  By  the  29th  canon 
of  our  Church,  no  parent  is  to  be  admitted 
to  answer  as  godfather  to  his  own  child. — 
Bp.  Gibson's  Codex,  vol.  i.  p.  439.  (See 
Sponsors.) 

The  form  of  administering  baptism  is  too 
well  known  to  require  a  particular  account 
to  be  given  of  it.  We  shall  only  observe 
some  of  the  more  material  differences 
between  the  form,  as  it  stood  in  the  first 
litiu:gy  of  King  Edward,  and  that  in  our 
Common  Prayer  Book  at  present.  First, 
in  that  of  King  Edward,  we  meet  with  a 
form  of  exorcism,  founded  upon  the  like 
practice  of  the  primitive  Church,  which  oui 
reformers  left  out,  when  they  took  a  re- 
view of  the  liturgy  in  the  5th  and  6th  of 
that  king.     It  begins  :- 


the 


o-  -    — o 

"  TJien  let  the  priest,  loolcing  upon 
children,  say ; 

"  I  command  thee,  unclean  spirit,  in  the 
name  of  the  Father,  and  of  the  Son,  and 
of  the  Holy  Ghost,  that  thou  come  out,  and 
depart  from  these  infants,  whom  our  Lord 
Jesus  Christ  hath  vouchsafed  to  caU  to  his 
holy  baptism,  to  be  made  members  of  his 
body,  and  of  his  holy  congregation,"  &c. 

The  form  of  consecrating  the  water  did 
not  make  a  part  of  the  office  in  King 
Edward's  liturgy,  as  it  does  in  the  present, 
because  the  water  in  the  font  was  changed 
and  consecrated  but  once  a  month.  The 
form  likewise  itself  was  something  different 
from  that  we  now  use,  and  was  introduced 
with  a  short  prayer,  that  "Jesus  Christ, 
upon  whom  (when  he  was  baptized)  the 
Holy  Ghost  came  down  in  the  likeness  of 
a  dove,  would  send  down  the  same  Holy 
Spirit,  to  sanctify  the  fountain  of  baptism ; 
which  prayer  was  afterwards  left  out,  at  the 
second  review. 

In  King  Edward's  First  Prayer  Book,  the 
minister  is  directed  to  "  dip  the  child  in  the 


BAPTISM 

water  thrice ;  first  dipping  the  right  side  ; 
secondly,  the  left ;  the  third  time  dipping 
the  face  toward  the  font."  This  trine  im- 
mersion was  a  very  ancient  practice  in 
the  Christian  Church,  and  used  in  honour 
of  the  Holy  Trinity :  though  some  later 
writers  say,  it  was  done  to  represent  the 
death,  burial,  and  resurrection  of  Christ, 
together  with  his  three  days'  continuance 
in  the  grave.  Afterward^,  the  Arians 
making  an  Ul  use  of  it,  by  persuading  the 
people  that  it  was  used  to  denote  that  the 
three  persons  in  the  Trinity  were  three 
distinct  substances,  the  orthodox  left  it 
off,  and  used  only  one  single  immersion.- — 
Tertull.  adv.  Prax.  c.  26  ;  Greg.  Nyss.  de 
Bapt.  Ghristi ;    Cyril,  Catech.  Mystag. 

In  the  same  book,  after  the  child  was  bap- 
tised, the  godfathers  and  godmothers  were 
instructed  to  lay  their  hands  upon  it,  and 
the  minister  was  to  put  on  him  the  white 
■vestment  commonly  called  the  Chrysome, 
and  to  say :  "  Take  this  white  vesture,  as  a 
■token  of  the  innocency  which,  by  God's  grace, 
in  this  holy  sacrament  of  baptism,  is  given 
'unto  thee;  and  for  a  sign,  whereby  thou 
art  admonished,  so  long  as  thou  livest,  to 
give  thyself  to  innocence  of  living,  that, 
after  this  transitory  life,  thou  mayest  be 
partaker  of  the  life  everlasting.  Amen." 
As  soon  as  he  had  pronounced  these  words, 
lie  was  to  anoint  the  infant  on  the  head, 
saying,  "Almighty  God,  the  Father  of  our 
liord  Jesus  Christ,  who  hath  regenerated 
.thee  by  water  and  the  Holy  Ghost,  and 
iath  given  unto  thee  remission  of  all  thy 
sins;  vouchsafe  to  anoint  thee  with  the 
■unction  of  his  Holy  Spirit,  and  bring  thee 
to  the  inheritance  of  everlasting  life. 
Amen."  This  was  manifestly  done  in  imi- 
tation of  the  practice  of  the  primitive 
-Church.     (See  Chrysome.) 

The  custom  of  sprinkling  children,  in- 
istead  of  dipping  them  in  the  font,  which 
.at  first  was  allowed  in  case  of  the  weak- 
ness or  sickness  of  the  infant,  has  so  far 
prevailed,  that  immersion  is  at  length 
almost  excluded.  What  principally  tended 
to  confirm  the  practice  of  affusion  or  sprink- 
ling, was,  that  several  of  our  English 
divines,  flying  into  Germany  and  Swtzer- 
land,  dming  the  bloody  reign  of  Queen 
Mary,  and  returning  home  when  Queen 
Elizabeth  came  to  the  cro^wn,  brought  back 
'with  them  a  great  zeal  for  the  Protestant 
Churches  beyond  sea  where  they  had  been 
.sheltered  and  received ;  and,  having  ob- 
served that  at  Geneva  (Calvin,  Instit.  lib. 
(iv.  c.  15)  and  some  other  places  baptism 
was  administered  by  sprinkling,  they 
•thought  they  could  not  do  the  Church  of 
England  a  greater  piece  of  service  than  by 
introducing  a  practice  dictated  by  so  great 
-an  oracle  as  Calvin.     This,  together  with 


BAPTISM 


7D 


the  coldness  of  our  northern  climate,  was 
what  contributed  to  banish  entirely  the 
practice  of  dipping  infants  in  the  font. 

It  remains  to  be  observed,  that,  by  a 
pro'vincial  constitution,  made  in  the  year 
1236,  (26th  of  Hen.  III.,)  neither  the  water, 
nor  the  vessel  containing  it,  which  have 
been  made  use  of  in  private  baptism,  are 
afterwards  to  be  applied  to  common  uses: 
but,  out  of  reverence  to  the  sacrament,  the 
water  is  to  be  poured  into  the  fire,  or  else 
carried  into  the  church  and  put  into  the 
font;  and  the  vessel  to  be  burnt,  or  else 
appropriated  to  some  use  in  the  church. 
But  no  provision  is  made  for  the  disposition 
of  the  water  used  in  the  font  at  church. 
In  the  Greek  Church,  particular  care  is 
taken  that  it  be  not  thrown  into  the  street 
like  common  water,  but  poured  into  a 
hollow  place  under  the  altar  (called 
6aXaa-<ri&iov  or  x''"'^^'"',}  where  it  is  soaked 
into  the  earth,  or  finds  a  passage. — Brough- 
ton ;  Bp.  Gibson's  Codex,  tit.  xviii.  c.  2,  vol. 
i.  p.  435  ;  Dr.  Smith's  Account  of  the  Gr. 
Church.     [H.] 

BAPTISM,  ADULT.  "It  was  thought 
convenient,  that  some  prayers  and  thanks- 
givings, fitted  to  special  occasions,  should 
be  added ;  particularly  an  ofiioe  for  the 
baptism  for  such  as  are  of  riper  years ; 
which,  although  not  so  necessary  when  the 
former  book  was  compiled,  yet  by  the 
growth  of  anabaptism,  through  the  licen- 
tiousness of  the  late  times  crept  in  amongst 
us,  is  now  become  necessary,  and  may  be 
always  useful  for  the  baptizing  of  natives 
in  our  plantations,  and  others  converted  to 
the  faith." — Preface  to  the  Booh  of  Com- 
mon Prayer. 

Rubric.  "  When  any  such  persons  of 
riper  years  are  to  be  baptized,  timely  notice 
shall  be  given  to  the  bishop,  or  whom  he 
shall  appoint  for  that  purpose,  a  week 
before  at  the  least,  by  the  parents  or  some 
other  discreet  persons;  that  so  due  care 
may  be  taken  for  their  examination,  whe- 
ther they  be  sufiiciently  instructed  in  the 
principles  of  the  Christian  rehgion ;  and 
that  they  may  be  exhorted  to  prepai-e 
themselves  with  prayers  and  fasting  for 
the  receiving  of  this  holy  sacrament.  And 
if  they  shall  be  found  fit,  then  the  god- 
fathers and  godmothers  (the  people  being 
assembled  on  the  Sunday  or  holy  day 
appointed)  shall  be  ready  to  present  them 
at  the  font,  immediately  after  the  second 
lesson,  either  at  morning  or  evening  prayer, 
as  the  curate  in  his  discretion  shall  think 
fit.  And  it  is  expedient  that  every  person 
thus  baptized  should  be  confirmed  by  the 
bishop,  so  soon  after  his  baptism  as  con- 
veniently may  be ;  that  so  he  may  be  ad- 
mitted to  the  holy  communion." 

BAPTISM,      INFANT.      Article      27. 


80 


BAPTISM 


"The  baptism  of  young  children  is  in 
anywise  to  he  retained  in  the  Church,  as 
most  agreeable  with  the  institution  of 
Christ." 

Rubric.  "  The  curates  of  every  parish 
shall  often  admonish  the  people,  that  they 
defer  not  the  baptism  of  their  children 
longer  than  the  first  or  second  Sunday 
next  after  their  birth,  or  other  holy  day 
falling  between;  unless  upon  a  great  and 
reasonable  cause,  to  be  approved  by  the 
curate." 

The  practice  of  infant  baptism  seems  to 
be  a  necessary  consequence  of  the  doctrine 
of  original  sin  and  of  the  grace  of  baptism. 
If  it  be  only  by  union  with  Christ  that 
the  children-  of  Adam  can  be  saved ;  and 
if,  as  the  Apostle  teaches,  in  baptism  "  we 
put  on  Christ,"  then  it  was  natural  for 
parents  to  ask  for  permission  to  bring  their 
little  ones  to  Christ,  that  they  might  be 
partakers  of  the  free  grace  that  is  offered 
to  all;  but  though  offered  to  all,  to  be 
applied  individually.  It  may  be  because 
it  is  so  necessary  a  consequence  of  the 
doctrine  of  original  sin,  that  the  rite  of 
infant  baptism  is  not  enjoined  in  Scripture. 
But  though  there  is  no  command  in  Scrip- 
ture to  baptize  infants,  and  although  for 
the  practice  we  must  plead  the  tradition 
of  the  Church  Universal,  still  we  may  find 
a  warrant  in  Scripture  in  favour  of  the 
traditional  practice.  We  find  it  generally 
stated  that  the  apostles  baptized  whole 
households,  and  Christ  our  Saviour  com- 
manded them  to  baptize  all  nations,  of 
which  infants  form  a  considerable  part. 
And  in  giving  this  injunction,  we  may 
presume  that  he  intended  to  include  in- 
fants, from  the  very  fact  of  bis  not  ex- 
cluding  them.  For  he  was  addressing 
Jews ;  and  when  the  Jews  converted  a  hea- 
then to  faith  in  the  God  of  Israel,  they  were 
accustomed  to  baptize  the  convert,  together 
with  all  the  infants  of  Ms  family.  And, 
consequently,  when  our  Lord  commanded 
Jews,  i.e.  men  accustomed  to  this  practice, 
to  baptize  nations,  the  fact  that  he  did  not 
positively  repel  infants,  implied  an  injunc- 
tion to  iaptize  them ;  and  when  the  Holy 
Spirit  records  that  the  Apostles,  in  obe- 
dience to  that  injunction,  baptized  whole 
households,  the  argument  gains  increased 
force.  This  is  probably  what  St.  Paul 
means,  when,  in  the  seventh  chapter  of  the 
First  Corinthians,  verse  14,  he  speaks  of 
the  children  of  believers  as  being  holy: 
they  are  so  far  holy,  that  they  may  be 
brought  to  the  sacrament  of  baptism. 
From  the  Apostles  has  come  down  the 
practice  of  baptizing  infants,  the  Church 
l-equiring  security,  through  certain  sponsors, 
that  the  children  shall  be  brought  up  to 
lead  a  godly  and  a  Christian  life.     And  by 


BAPTISM 

the  early  Christians  the  practice  was  con- 
sidered sufficiently  sanctioned  by  the  pas- 
sage from  St.  Mark,  which  is  read  in  our 
baptismal  office,  in  which  we  are  told,  that 
the  Lord  Jesus  Christ,  having  rebuked 
those  that  would  have  kept  the  children 
from  him,  took  them  up  in  bis  arms  and 
blessed  them.  He  blessed  them,  and  his 
blessing  must  have  conveyed  grace  to  their 
souls;  therefore,  of  grace,  children  may  be 
partakers.  They  may  receive  spiritual  life, 
though  it  may  be  long  before  that  life 
develop  itself;  and  that  life  they  may  lose 
by  sinning. 

BAPTISM,  PRIVATE.  JSuliric.  "  The 
curates  of  every  parish  shall  often  warn  the 
people,  that  without  great  cause  and  ne- 
cessity, they  procure  not  their  children  to 
be  baptized  at  home  in  their  houses." 

Canon  69  insists  on  the  obligation  of 
ministers  baptizing  infants  in  danger  of 
death.  If,  having  been  sunamoned,  the 
minister  neglect  to  go,  and  the  infant  dies 
unbaptized,  the  said  minister  shall  be  sus- 
pended for  three  months. 

Rubric.  "  The  child  being  named  by  some 
one  that  is  present,  the  minister  shall  pour 
water  upon  it. 

"And  let  them  not  doubt,  but  that  the 
child  so  baptized  is  lawfully  and  sufficiently 
baptized,  and-  ought  not  to  be  baptized 
again.  Yet,  nevertheless,  if  the  child 
which  is  after  this  sort  baptized  do  after- 
ward live,  it  is  expedient  that  it  be  brought 
into  the  church,  to  the  intent  that  the 
congregation  may  be  certified  of  the  true 
form  of  baptism  privately  before  adminis- 
tered to  such  child." 

BAPTISM,  PUBLIC.  At  first  baptism 
was  administered  publicly,  as  occasion 
served,  by  rivers;  afterwards  the  baptis-- 
tery  was  built,  at  the  entrance  of  the 
church  or  very  near  it,  which  had  a  large 
basin  in  it,  that  held  the  persons  to  be 
baptized,  and  they  went  down  by  steps 
into  it.  Afterwards,  when  immersion 
came  to  be  disused,  fonts  were  set  up  at 
the  entrance  of  churches. 

By  the  "Laws  Ecclesiastical"  of  King 
Edmund,  it  is  directed  that  there  shall  be 
a  font  of  stone,  or  other  competent  mate- 
rial, in  every  church;  which  shall  be  de- 
cently covered  and  kept,  and  not  converted 
to  other  uses. 

And  by  canon  81,  There  shall  be  a  font 
of  stone  in  every  church  and  chapel  where 
baptism  is  to  be  administered ;  the  same  to 
be  set  in  the  ancient  usual  places:  in 
which  only  font  the  minister  shall  baptize 
publicly. 

"The  rubric  directs  that  the  people  are 
to  be  admonished,  that  it  is  most  conveni- 
ent that  baptism  shall  not  be  administered 
but  upon  Sundays  and  other  holy  days. 


BAPTISM 

■when  the  most  number  of  people  come  to- 
gether; as  well  for  that  the  congregation 
there  present  may  testify  the  receiving  of 
them  that  be  newly  baptized  into  the 
number  of  Christ's  Church,  as  also  because 
in  the  baptism  of  infants,  every  man  pre- 
sent may  be  put  in  remembrance  of  his 
own  profession  made  to  God  in  his  bap- 
tism. Nevertheless,  if  necessity  so  require, 
children  may  be  baptized  upon  any  other 
day." 

And  by  canon  68,  No  minister  shall 
refuse  or  delay  to  christen  any  child 
according  to  the  form  of  the  Book  of 
Common  Prayer,  that  is  brought  to  the 
church  to  him  upon  Sundays  and  holy 
days  to  be  christened  (convenient  warning 
being  given  him  thereof  before).  And 
if  he  shall  refuse  so  to  do,  he  shall  be  sus- 
pended by  the  bishop  of  the  diocese  from 
his  ministry  by  the  space  of  three  months. 

The  rubric  also  directs,  that  when  there 
are  children  to  be  baptized,  the  parents 
shall  give  knowledge  thereof  over-night, 
or  in  the  morning  before  the  beginning  of 
morning  prayer,  to  the  curate. 

The  rubric  further  directs,  that  there 
shall  be  for  every  male  child  to  be  bap- 
tized two  godfathers  and  one  godmother ; 
and  for  every  female,  one  godfather  and 
two  godmothers. 

By  the  29th  canon  it  is  directed,  that  no 
parent  shall  be  urged  to  be  present,  nor 
admitted  to  answer  as  godfather  for  his 
own  child ;  nor  any  godfather  or  godmother 
shall  be  suffered  to  make  any  other  answer 
or  speech,  than  by  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer  is  prescribed  in  that  behalf.  Neither 
shall  any  persons  be  admitted  godfather 
or  godmother  to  any  child  at  christening  or 
confirmation,  before  the  said  person  so  imder- 
taking  hath  received  the  holy  communion. 

According  to  the  rubric,  the  godfathers 
and  godmothers,  and  the  people  with  the 
children,  must  be  ready  at  the  font,  either 
immediately  after  the  last  lesson  at  morn- 
ing prayer,  or  else  immediately  after  the 
last  lesson  at  evenitig  prayer,  as  the  curate 
by  his  discretion  shall  stppoint. 

The  rubric  appoints  that  the  priest  com- 
ing to  the  font,  which  is  then  to  be  filled 
with  pure  water,  shall  perform  the  office  of 
public  baptism. 

It  may  be  here  observed,  that  the  ques- 
tions in  the  office  of  the  2nd  Book  of  f  idward 
VI.,  "  Dost  thou  renounce  ?  "  and  so  on,  were 
put  to  the  child,  and  not  to  the  godfathers 
and  godmothers,  which  (with  all  due  sub- 
mission) seemsjmore  applicable  to  the  end 
of  the  institution;  besides  that  it  is  not 
consistent  (as  it  seems)  with  the  propriety 
of  language,  to  say  to  three  persons  collec- 
tively, "Dost  tliou  in  the  name  of  this 
child  do  this  or  that?" 


BAPTISM 


81 


By  a  constitution  of  Archbishop  Peck- 
ham,  the  ministers  are  to  take  care  not  to 
permit  wanton  names,  which  being  pro- 
nounced do  sound  to  lasoiviousness,  to  be 
given  to  children  baptized,  especially  of 
the  female  sex ;  and  if  otherwise  it  be  done, 
the  same  shall  be  changed  by  the  bishop 
at  confirmation ;  which  being  so  changed 
at  confirmation  (Lord  Coke  says)  shall  be 
deemed  the  lawful  name,  though  this  ap- 
pears to  be  no  longer  the  case.  In  the 
ancient  offices  of  Confirmation,  the  bishop 
pronounced  the  name  of  the  child;  and  if 
the  bishop  did  not  approve  of  tbe  name,  or 
the  person  to  be  confirmed,  or  his  friends, 
desired  it  to  be  altered,  it  might  be  done  by 
the  bishop's  then  pronounci-ng  a  new  name; 
but  by  the  form  of  the  present  liturgy,  the 
bishop  doth  not  pronounce  the  name  of  the 
person  to  be  confirmed,  and  therefore  can- 
not alter  it. 

The  rubric  goes  on  to  direct — The  priest, 
taking  the  child  into  his  hands,  shall  say 
to  the  godfathers  and  godmothers,  "  Name 
this  child : "  and  then  naming  it  after  them, 
(if  they  shall  certify  him  that  the  child 
may  well  endure  it,)  he  shall  dip  it  in  the 
water  discreetly  and  warUy,  saying,  "  N.  I 
baptize  thee  in  the  name  of  the  Father, 
and  of  the  Son,  and  of  the  Holy  Ghost." 
But  if  they  certify  that  the  child  is  weak, 
it  shall  suffice  to  pour  water  upon  it. 

Here  we  may  observe  that  the  dipping 
by  the  office  of  the  2nd  Book  of  Edward  VI. 
was  not  of  the  whole  body  ;  but  they  first 
dipped  the  right  side,  then  the  left,  then 
the  face  towards  the  font. 

The  rubric  directs  that  the  minister  shall 
sign  the  child  vsdth  the  sign  of  the  cross. 
And  to  take  away  all  scruple  concerning 
the  same,  the  true  explication  thereof,  and 
the  just  reasons  for  retaining  of  this  cere- 
mony, are  set  forth  in  the  thirtieth  canon. 
The  substance  of  which  canon  is  this,  that 
the  first  Christians  gloried  in  the  cross  of 
Christ;  that  the  Scripture  sets  forth  our 
whole  redemption  under  the  name  of  the 
cross ;  that  the  sign  of  the  cross  was  used 
by  the  first  Christians  in  all  their  actions, 
and  especially  in  the  baptizing  of  theu- 
children ;  that  the  abuse  of  it  by  the  Church 
of  Eome  does  not  take  away  the  lawful  use 
of  it ;  that  the  same  has  been  approved  by 
the  reformed  divines,  with  sufficient  cau- 
tions nevertheless  against  superstition  in 
the  use  of  it ;  that  it  is  no  part  of  the  sub- 
stance of  this  sacrament,  and  that  the  infant 
baptized  is  by  virtue  of  baptism,  before  it 
be  signed  with  the  sign  of  the  cross,  received 
into  the  congregation  of  Christ's  flock  as  a 
perfect  member  thereof,  and  not  by  any 
power  ascribed  to  the  sign  of  the  cross  ;  and 
therefore,  that  the  same,  being  purged  from 
all  Popish  superstition  and  error,  and  re- 

Q 


82 


BAPTISM 


duced  to  its  primary  institution,  upon  those 
riiles  of  doctrine  concerning  things  indiflfer- 
ent  which  are  consonant  to  the  word  of 
God  and  to  the  judgments  of  all  the  ancient 
fathers,  ought  to  be  retained  in  the  Church, 
considering  that  things  of  themselves  in- 
different do,  in  some  sort,  alter  their  natures 
•when  they  become  enjoined  and  not  pro- 
hibited by  lawful  authority. 

BAPTISM,  EEGISTRATION  OF. 
When  the  minister  has  baptized  the  child 
he  has  a  further  duty  to  perform,  in  making 
an  entry  thereof  in  the  parish  register,  which 
is  a  book  in  which  formerly  all  christenings, 
marriages,  and  burials  were  recorded,  and 
the  use  of  which  is  enforced  both  by  the 
canon  law  and  by  the  statute. 

The  keeping  of  parochial  registries  of 
baptism,  and  also  of  burial,  are,  so  far  as 
regards  the  duties  of  clergymen  in  that 
respect,  regulated  by  the  statute  52  Geo. 
III.  c.  146,  whereby  it  is  enacted  that  re- 
gisters of  pubUo  and  private  baptisms, 
marriages,  and  burials,  solenmized  accord- 
ing to  the  rites  of  our  Church,  shall  be 
made  and  kept  by  the  rector  or  other  the 
officiating  minister  of  every  parish  or  cha- 
pelry,  on  books  of  parchment,  or  durable 
paper,  to  be  provided  by  the  king's  printer, 
at  the  expense  of  the  parishes;  and  the 
particular  form  of  the  book,  and  of  the 
manner  of  making  the  entries,  are  directed 
according  to  a  form  in  the  schedule  to 
the  act. 

The  register  book  is  to  be  deemed  the 
property  of  the  parish;  the  custody  of  it 
is  to  be  in  the  rector  or  other  officiating 
minister,  by  whom  it  is  to  be  kept  in  an 
iron  chest  provided  by  the  parish,  either 
in  his  own  house,  if  he  resides  in  the  parish, 
or  in  the  church,  and  the  book  is  to  be 
taken  from  the  chest  only  for  the  purpose 
of  making  entries,  being  produced  when 
necessary  in  evidence,  or  for  some  of  the 
purposes  mentioned  in  the  Act. 

The  Act  6  &  7  W.  IV.,  called  the  General 
Eegistration  Act,  provides  that  nothing 
therein  contained  shall  affect  the  registration 
of  baptisms  or  burials,  as  now  by  law 
established  ;  so  that  whatever  any  parish- 
ioner, incumbent,  or  curate  had  respectively 
a  right  to  insist  upon,  with  regard  to  the 
regulation  of  baptisms,  may  be  equally 
insisted  upon  by  either  party  now.  There 
are,  however,  enactments  of  6  &  7  W.  IV. 
c.  86,  which  are  to  be  observed  in  addition 
to  those  of  52  Geo.  III.  c.  146. 

If  any  child  born  in  England,  whose  birth 
shall  have  been  registered  according  to  the 
provisions  of  6  &  7  W.  IV.  c.  86,  shall, 
within  six  calendar  months  after  it  has 
been  so  registered,  have  any  name  given  to 
it  in  baptism,  the  parents  or  persons  so 
procuring  such  name    to  be  given    may, 


BAPTISTS 

within  seven  days  afterwards,  procure  and 
deliver  to  the  registrar  a  certificate  ac- 
cording to  a  prescribed  form,  signed  by  the 
minister  who  shall  have  performed  the  rite 
of  baptism,  which  certificate  the  minister  is 
required  to  deliver  immediately  after  the 
baptism,  whenever  it  shall  then  be  de- 
manded, on  payment  of  the  fee  of  Is.,  which 
he  shall  be  entitled  to  receive  for  the  same ; 
and  the  registrar,  or  superintendent  registrar, 
upon  the  receipt  of  that  certificate,  and 
upon  payment  of  a  fee  of  Is.,  shall,  without 
any  erasure  of  the  original  entry,  forthwith 
register  that  the  child  was  baptized  by  such 
a  name;  and  such  registrar,  or  super- 
intendent registrar,  shall  thereupon  certify 
upon  the  certificate  the  additional  entry  so 
made,  and  forthwith  send  the  certificate 
through  the  post  to  the  registrar-general. 
Every  rector,  &o.,  and  every  registrar,  &o., 
who  shall  have  the  keeping  for  the  time 
being  of  any  register  book,  shall,  at  all 
reasonable  times,  allow  searches  to  be  made, 
and  shall  give  a  copy  certified  under  his 
hand  of  any  entry  or  entries  in  the  same, 
upon  payment  of  a  fee  of  Is.,  for  every 
search  extending  over  a  period  of  not  more 
than  one  year,  and  6d.  additional  for  every 
half    year,  and  2s.    6d.  for    every  -single 

BAPTl'sTEEY.  Properly  a  separate,  or 
special,  building  for  the  administration  of 
holy  baptism.  In  this  sense,  a  baptistery, 
originally  intended  and  used  for  the  purpose, 
exists  in  England  at  Cranbrook  in  Kent ; 
for  that  which  is  called  the  baptistery  at 
Canterbury,  and  contains  the  font,  was 
never  so  called,  or  so  furnished,  tiU  the  last 
century.  The  remains  of  an  ancient  bap- 
tistery chapel  have  lately  been  discovered 
in  Ely  cathedral ;  and  the  chapel  has  now 
been  restored. 

One  of  the  most  ancient  baptisteries  now 
existing  is  that  of  St.  John  Lateran  at 
Rome,  erected  by  Constantine.  It  is  a 
detached  building,  and  octagonal.  In  the 
centre  is  a  large  font  of  green  basalt,  into 
which  the  persons  to  be  baptized  descended 
by  the  four  steps  which  still  remain.  It 
has  two  side  chapels  or  exedrse. 

Detached  baptisteries  still  exist  in  many 
cities  in  Italy :  the  most  famous  are  those 
at  Florence  and  Pisa.  These  served  for  the 
whole  city ;  anciently  no  town  churches 
but  the  cathedral  church  having  fonts. 
(See  Bingham,  book  viii,  ch.  7,  §  6.) 

Sometimes  the  canopy  to  the  font  grows 
to  so  great  amplitude  as  to  be  supported  by 
its  own  pillars,  and  to  receive  persons  within 
it  at  the  baptismal  service,  and  then  it  may 
be  called  a  baptistery.  This  is  the  case  at 
Trunch  and  at  Aylsbam,  both  in  Norfolk. 
(See  Font.) — Diet  Christ.  Ant.  i.  176. 

BAPTISTS.     A  name  assumed  by  those 


BAPTISTS 

■who  deny  the  validity  of  infant  baptism, 
defer  the  baptism  of  tlieir  own  children, 
and  admit  proselytes  into  their  community 
by  a  second  baptism.  They  would  be  more 
properly  called  Anabaptists,  from  their  bap- 
tizing again  (see  Anabaptists) ;  or  Antipajdo- 
baptists,  from  their  denying  the  validity  of 
infant  baptism. 

1.  History.  The  Baptists  sprang  origin- 
ally from  the  Brownists,  or  early  Independ- 
ents, who  had  a  good  deal  of  communication 
with  the  Dutch  Anabaptists.  In  1633, 
from  a  congregation  of  Dissenters  of  this 
sort,  a  number  determined  to  secede,  and 
form  a  new  congregation  of  their  own, 
holding  very  distinct  views  against  infant 
baptism.  This  they  did  imder  Spilsbury, 
and  were  the  first  assembly  of  so  called 
Baptists.  Another  congregation  was  formed 
in  Crutched  Friars  in  1639,  of  whom  one 
Blunt  was  sent  over  to  Holland  to  be 
baptized,  and  on  his  return  baptized  the 
other  members.  But  though  thus  they 
acknowledged  the  principle,  they  did  not  of 
course  hold  apostolic  succession.  (Crosby's 
Sist.  Eng.  Baptists,  i.  101  seq.)  Their 
numbers  increased,  and  in  1646  there  were 
said  to  be  forty-six  of  their  congregations 
in  and  about  London,  and  in  America  also 
Eoger  Williams  was  propagating  the  doc- 
trines of  this  sect.  During  the  Eebellion 
the  Baptists  exercised  considerable  influence, 
but  so  great  was  the  difference  of  opinion 
amongst  men  at  that  time,  and  with  so 
little  sound  thought  was  it  accompanied, 
that  in  one  year  (March  1647)  a  declaration 
in  favour  of  Baptist  theories  was  pro- 
mulgated by  the  Lords  and  Commons, 
while  in  the  next  year  (May  2,  1648)  an 
ordinance  was  passed  declaring  that  the 
propagation  of  such  doctrine  was  unlawful. 
— Neale's  Hist.  Purit.  iii.  375. 

Before  the  Eestoration  a  division  took 
place  among  the  Baptists,  though  they  had 
been  in  existence  so  short  a  time,  (i.)  The 
General  Baptists,  called  also  Arminian 
Baptists,  held  the  anti-Calvinistio  doc- 
trine— that  Christ  died  to  save  all,  not  only 
an  elect  few.  These  became  imbued  with 
Unitarian  ideas  so  much  that  in  1770  a 
number  seceded  from  them  and  called 
themselves  the  "New  Connection  of 
General  Baptists."  (ii.)  Tlie  Particular 
Baptists  retain  the  same  opinions  as  their 
sect  did  when  it  was  first  originated  in 
1633.  Their  title  is  derived  from  their 
ioldmg  the  Calvinistic  doctrine  of  "  Par- 
ticular Eedemption."  The  Baptist  Union 
was  formed  in  1812,  in  order  to  unite  the 
different  sections,  but  the  term  "  Baptist " 
generally  means  the  Particular  Baptists. 
Of  late  years  there  has  been  a  great  amount 
of  energy  amongst  this  sect,  and  especially 
■with  regard  to  providing  education  for  their 


BAPTISTS 


83 


ministers.  There  are  ten  colleges  in  Eng- 
land, Wales,  and  Scotland  for  this  purpose  ; 
and  Mr.  C.  H.  Spurgeon  in  London  has  not 
only  caused  a  large  "  tabernacle"  or  chapel 
to  be  raised  for  his  ministrations,  hut  has 
organised  schools,  training  associations,  and 
other  institutions  in  connexion  with  it, 
which  reflect  the  highest  credit  upon  his 
perseverance,  abUity,  and  power  of  organisa- 
tion. 

U.  Doctrine.  The  members  of  this 
denomination  are  distinguished  from  all 
other  professing  Christians  by  their  opinions 
respecting  the  ordinance  of  Christian  bap- 
tism. Conceiving  that  positive  institutions 
cannot  be  established  by  analogical  reason- 
ing, but  depend  on  the  will  of  the  Saviour 
revealed  in  express  precepts,  and  that 
apostolical  example  illustrative  of  this  is 
the  rule  of  duty,  they  differ  from  their 
Christian  brethren  with  regard  both  to  the 
subjects  and  the  mode  of  baptism.  With 
respect  to  the  subjects,  from  the  command 
which  Christ  gave  after  his  resurrection, 
and  in  which  baptism  is  mentioned  as  con- 
sequent to  faith  in  the  Gospel,  they  conceive 
them  to  be  those,  and  those  only,  who 
believe  what  the  apostles  were  then  enjoined 
to  preach.  With  respect  to  the  mode,  they 
affirm  that,  instead  of  the  water  being 
sprinkled  or  poured,  the  person  ought  to  be 
immersed  in  it,  referring  to  the  primitive 
practice,  and  observing  that  the  baptizer  as 
well  as  the  baptized  having  gone  down  into 
the  water,  the  latter  is  baptized  in  it  and  both 
come  up  out  of  it.  (Acts  viii.  38,  39.)  They 
say  that  John  baptized  in  the  Jordan,  and  that 
Jesus,  after  being  baptized,  came  up  out  of  it. 
BeUevers  are  said  also  to  be  "  buried  with 
Christ  by  baptism  into  death,  wherein  also 
they  are  risen  with  Him ;"  and  the  Baptists 
insist  that  this  is  a  doctrinal  allusion  in- 
compatible with  any  other  mode  than  im- 
mersion. But  they  say  that  their  views  of 
this  institution  are  much  more  confirmed, 
and  may  be  better  understood,  by  studying 
its  nature  and  import.  They  consider  it  as 
an  impressive  emblem  of  that  by  which 
their  sins  are  remitted  or  washed  away,  and 
of  that  on  account  of  which  the  Holy  Spirit 
is  given  to  those  who  obey  the  Messiah.  In 
other  words,  they  view  Christian  baptism 
as  a  figurative  representation  of  that  which 
the  Gospel  of  Jesus  is  in  testimony.  To 
this  the  mind  of  the  baptized  is  therefore 
naturally  led,  while  spectators  are  to  con- 
sider him  as  professing  his  faith  in  the 
Gospel,  and  his  subjection  to  the  Eedeemer. 
The  Baptist  therefore  would  say,  that  none 
ought  to  be  baptized  except  those  who  seem 
to  believe  this  Gospel ;  and  that  immersion 
is  not  properly  a  mode  of  baptism,  but 
baptism  itself. 

Thus  the  English  and  most  foreign  Bap- 

G  2 


84 


BAKDESANISTS 


tists  consider  a  personal  profession  of  faith 
and  an  immersion  in  water  as  essential  to 
■baptism.  The  profession  of  faith  is  generally- 
made  before  the  congregation,  at  a  church 
meeting.  On  these  occasions  some  have  a 
creed  to  which  they  expect  the  candidate  to 
assent,  and  to  give  a  circumstantial  account 
of  his  conversion ;  but  others  require  only  a 
profession  of  his  faith  as  a  Christian.  The 
former  generally  consider  baptism  as  an 
ordinance,  which  initiates  persons  into  a 
particular  church ;  and  they  say  that  with- 
out breach  of  Christian  liberty,  they  have  a 
right  to  expect  an  agreement  in  articles  of 
faith  in  their  own  societies.  The  latter 
think  that  baptism  initiates  merely  into  a 
profession  of  the  Christian  religion,  and 
therefore  say  that  they  have  no  right  to 
require  an  assent  to  their  creed  from  such 
as  do  Bot  intend  to  join  their  communion  ; 
and  in  support  of  their  opinion,  they  quote 
the  baptism  of  the  eunuch,  in  the  eighth 
chapter  of  the  Acts  of  the  Apostles.  Some 
of  both  the  general  and  particular  sections 
allow  mixed  communion,  by  which  is  under- 
stood, that  those  who  have  not  been  baptized 
by  immersion  on  the  profession  of  their 
faith,  (but  in  their  infancy,  which  they 
themselves  deem  valid,)  may  sit  down  at 
the  Lord's  table  along  with  those  who  have 
been  baptized.  This  has  given  rise  to  much 
controversy  on  the  subject. 

Some  of  both  classes  of  Baptists  are,  at 
the  same  time,  Sabbatarians,  and,  with  the 
Jews,  observe  the  seventh  day  of  the  week 
as  the  Sabbath.  This  has  been  adopted  by 
them  from  a,  persuasion  that  all  the  ten 
commandments  are  in  their  nature  strictly 
moral,  and  that  the  observance  of  the 
seventh  day  was  never  abrogated  or  re- 
pealed by  our  Saviour  or  his  apostles. 

In  discipline,  the  Baptists  differ  little 
from  the  Independents.  In  Scotland  they 
have  some  peculiarities,  not  necessary  to 
notice.    [H.] 

BAEDESANISTS.  Christian  heretics  in 
the  Bast,  and  the  followers  of  Bardesanes, 
or  Bardaisan,  son  of  Daisan,  who  lived  in 
Mesopotamia  in  the  second  century,  and 
was  first  the  disciple  of  Valentinus,  but 
quitted  that  heresy,  and  vsrrote  not  only 
against  it,  but  against  the  Marcionite  and 
other  heresies  of  his  time;  he  afterwards 
unhappily  fell  into  the  errors  he  had  refuted. 
The  Bardesanists  differed  from  the  Catholic 
Church  on  three  points  :  1.  They  held  the 
devil  to  be  a  self-existent,  independent 
being.  2.  They  taught  that  our  Lord  was 
not  born  of  a  woman,  but  brought  his  body 
with  him  from  heaven.  3.  They  denied 
the  resurrection  of  the  body.  (Euseb.  Eist. 
Ecdes.  iv.  c.  30 ;  Epiph.  Eagres.  5,  6  ;  Origen, 
contr  Mardon,  §  3,  p.  70,  ed.  Wetstein.)  Two 
good  mor.ographs  on  Bardaisan  have  been 


BARSANIANS 

produced  in  Germany  (i.)  by  Merx,  1863, 
(ii.)  by  Hilgenfeld,  1864.  (See  Diet,  oj 
Christian  Biography,  s.  v.  Bardaisan.) 

BARNABAS,  EPISTLE  OF.  The 
Epistle  of  St.  ]3amabas  was  published  by 
Archbishop  Wake,  among  his  translations 
of  the  works  of  the  Apostolic  Fathers  ;  but 
by  others  it  is  referred  to  the  second  century, 
and  is  supposed  to  be  the  work  of  a  converted 
Alexandrian  Jew.  By  Clemens  Alexandrinus 
and  Origen,  by  Busebius  and  St.  Jerome, 
the  work  is  attributed  to  St.  Barnabas, 
though  they  declare  that  it  ought  not  to  be 
esteemed  of  the  same  authority  as  the 
canonical  books,  "  because,  although  it 
really  belongs  to  St.  Barnabas,  yet  it  is  not 
generally  received  by  the  whole  Catholic 
Church." — Clem.  Alex.  Strom,  lib.  ii. ;  Orig. 
contr.  Cels.  lib.  i. ;  Du  Pin,  Can.  Scrip,  tom. 
ii.  c.  V. ;  Wake's  Genuine  Epist.  See  "  Apos- 
tolical Fathers,"  Smith's  Diet,  of  Christian 
Biotjraphy  ;  Hefele,  Das  Sendschreiben  des 
Apostels  Barnabas ;  and  J.  G.  Mtiller, 
JErkldrung  des  Barnabasbriefes. 

BARNABAS'  DAY  (ST.).  11th  of 
June.  This  apostle  was  bom  in  the  island 
of  Cyprus,  and  was  descended  from  parents 
of  the  house  of  Levi.  He  became  a  student 
of  the  Jewish  law,  under  Gamaliel,  who 
was  also  the  instructor  of  St.  Paul.  St. 
Barnabas  was  one  of  those  who  freely 
gave  up  his  worldly  goods  into  the  com- 
mon stock,  which  was  voluntarily  formed 
by  the  earliest  converts  to  Christianity. 
After  tiie  conversion  of  St.  Paul,  St.  Bar- 
nabas had  the  distinguished  honour  of 
introducing  him  into  the  society  of  the 
apostles ;  and  was  afterwards  his  fellow- 
labourer  in  many  places,  especially  at  An- 
tiooh,  where  the  name  of  Christian  was 
first  assumed  by  the  followers  of  Jesus. 
It  has  been  said  that  St.  Barnabas  founded 
the  Church  of  Milan,  and  that  he  was 
stoned  to  death  at  Salamis,  in  Cyprus  j 
but  these  accounts  are  very  uncertain. 
For  the  Epistle  ascribed  to  him,  see  the 
preceding  article. 

BAENABITES.  Called  canons  regular 
of  St.  Paul:  an  order  of  Romish  monks 
approved  by  Pope  Clement  VII.  and  Pope 
Paul  in.  There  have  been  several  learned 
men  of  the  order,  and  they  have  several 
monasteries  in  France,  Italy,  and  Savoy: 
they  call  them  by  the  name  of  canons  of 
St.  Paul,  because  their  first  founders  had 
their  denomination  from  their  reading  St. 
Paul's  Epistles ;  and  they  are  named  Bar- 
nabites  for  their  particular  devotion  for  St. 
Barnabas. — ^Du  Pin,  Eist.  Ant.  xvi. 

BARSANIANS,  or  SEMIDULITES. 
Heretics  that  began  to  appear  in  the  sixth 
age;  they  maintained  the  errors  of  the 
Gradanaites,  and  made  their  sacrifices 
consist  in   taking  wheat  flour  on  the  top- 


BAKTHOLOMEWS 

of  their  finger,   and   carrying  it  to   their 
mouths. 

BARTHOLOMEW'S  DAY  (ST.).  24th 
of  August  is  the  day  appointed  for  the 
commemoration  of  this  apostle.  In  the 
catalogue  of  the  apostles,  which  is  given 
by  the  first  three  of  the  Evangelists,  and  in 
the  Acts  (see  Apostles)  Bartholomew  makes 
one  of  the  number.  As  he  is  always  named 
by  them  immediately  after  Philip,  and  St. 
Jehu,  who  does  not  mention  Bartholomew, 
records  the  introduction  of  Nathanael  to  our 
Lord  by  Philip,  it  has  been  commonly  sup- 
posed that  Bartholomew  and  Nathanael  were 
the  same  person.  St.  Bartholomew  is  said 
to  have  preached  the  gospel  in  the  Greater 
Armenia,  and  to  have  converted  the  Lyca- 
onians  to  Christianity.  It  is  also  believed 
that  he  carried  the  gospel  into  India :  and 
as  there  is  no  record  of  his  return,  it  is  not 
improbable  that  he  sufiered  martyrdom  in 
that  country. — Euseb.  S.  E.  v.  10. 

On  St.  Bartholomew's  day  was  committed 
that  most  horrid  and  atrocious  carnage, 
called  the  Parisian  Massacre.  In  the  reign 
of  Charles  IX.,  numbers  of  the  principal 
Protestants,  or  Huguenots,  were  invited  to 
Paris,  under  solemn  oath  of  safety,  to 
celebrate  the  marriage  of  the  King  of 
Navarre,  with  the  sister  of  the  French  king. 
On  Aug.  24,  1572,  there  was  a  general 
massacre  of  the  "  heretics,"  the  king  him- 
self taking  part  in  it.  Ten  thousand  per- 
-sons  of  all  ranks,  and  among  them  Admiral 
Coligny,  were  slaughtered  in  Paris ;  and  the 
lust  of  carnage  spread.  At  most  of  the 
chief  towns  in  France,  and  especially  at 
Lyons,  similar  atrocities  were  committed, 
insomuch  that  it  is  asserted  that  on  this 
dreadful  occasion  more  than  30,000  persons 
were  put  to  death.  This  atrocious  massacre 
met  with  the  deliberate  approbation  of  the 
pope  and  authorities  of  the  Romish  Church. 
See  Hook's  Archbishops,  ix.  456 ;  White's 
Sisf.  of  the  Massacre  of  St.  Bartholomew 
(Murray.)    [H.] 

BARUCH  (THE  PROPHECY  OF). 
One  of  the  apocryphal  books,  subjoined 
to  the  canon  of  the  Old  Testament.  Ba- 
ruch  was  the  son  of  Neriah,  who  was  the 
disciple  and  amanuensis  of  the  prophet 
Jeremiah.  It  has  been  reckoned  part  of 
Jeremiah's  prophecy,  and  is  often  cited  by 
the  ancient  fathers  as  such.  Josephus 
tells  us,  Baruch  was  descended  of  a  noble 
family ;  and  it  is  said,  in  the  book  itself, 
that  he  wrote  this  prophecy  at  Babylon ; 
but  at  what  time  is  uncertain. — Clem. 
Alexand.  Piedag.  ch.  x. ;  Cyprian,  de  Testi- 
mon.  ad  Quirinum,  lib.  ii. 

Three  copies  of  this  book  are  extant,  one 
in  Greek,  two  in  Syriac;  but  which  of 
these,  if  any,  is  the  original,  is  uncertain. 
(Hieron.  in  Frasfat  ad  jerem.)    The  Jews 


BASILICA 


85 


rejected  this  book,  because  it  did  not  appear 
to  have  been  written  in  Hebrew ;  nor  is  it  in 
the  catalogue  of  sacred  books  given  us  by 
Origen,  Hilary,  RufBnus,  and  others.  But  in 
the  Pseudo-Laodicene  catalogue  and  in  those 
of  SS.  Cyril,  Epiphanius,  and  Athanasius,  it 
is  contained  as  a  separate  book. 

BASILIAN  MONKS.  Monks  of  the 
order  of  St.  Basil,  who  lived  in  the  fourth 
century.  He  founded  a  monastery  in  the 
province  of  Pontus  (Gibbon,  Decline  and 
Fall,  xxxvii.)  and  for  the  better  regulation 
of  this  new  society,  he  drew  up  certain  rules, 
which  were  to  be  binding  upon  all  who 
entered  his  order.  This  new  order  soon 
spread  over  all  the  East,  and  it  was  not  long 
before  it  passed  into  the  West.  Some 
authors  pretend  that  St.  Basil,  before  he 
died,  saw  himself  the  spiritual  father  of 
more  than  90,000  monks  in  the  East  only ; 
but  this  order,  which  flourished  for  more 
than  three  centuries,  was  considerably  di- 
minished by  heresy,  schism,  and  the  change 
of  Empire.  Constantine  Copronymus  per- 
secuted the  Basilian  Monks,  and  many  of 
their  monasteries  were  abandoned,  and  spoiled 
of  their  goods.  It  is  said  that  this  order 
produced  14  popes,  1805  bishops,  3010  ab- 
bots, and  11,085  martyrs.  It  also  boasts  of 
several  emperors,  kings  and  princes  who 
have  embraced  its  rule.  The  Basihan  Monks 
of  Sicily,  Calabria,  and  Rome  follow  the 
Greek  rite,  but  conform  in  many  things  to 
the  Latin  Church.  They  add  the  words 
"  qui  ex  patre  filioque  procedit,"  in  the 
Creed,  which  the  Greeks  do  not.  In  Spain 
Clement  VIII.  gave  the  Basilian  Monks 
constitutions,  which  are  inserted  in  his 
brief  of  Sept.  23, 1603.  The  order  of  St. 
Basil  prevails  almost  exclusively  in  the 
orthodox  Greek  Churches. — Tillemont,  Eist. 
JSccles.  tom.  ix.,  St.  Basil,  art.  21,  22. 

BASILICA.  The  halls  of  justice  and  of 
other  public  business  among  the  Romans 
were  thus  called ;  and  many  of  them  when 
converted  into  Christian  chiu'ches  retained 
the  same  name.  The  general  ground  plan 
of  the  basilica  was  also  frequently  retained 
in  the  erection  of  a  church.  The  basilica 
tenninated  with  a  conchoidal  recess,  or  apsis 
(see  Apse),  where  the  prsetor,  and  magistrate 
sat :  beneath  this  was  a  transverse  hall  or 
gallery,  the  origin  of  the  transept,  and  below 
was  the  great  hall  with  its  side  passages, 
afterwards  called  the  nave  and  aisles. 

The  bishop  of  Rome  had  seven  cathe- 
drals called  Basilicas.  Sis  of  these  were 
erected  or  converted  into  churches  by 
Constantine,  viz.  St.  John  Lateran,  (the 
regular  cathedral  of  Rome,)  the  ancient 
church  of  St.  Peter,  on  the  Vatican  Hill, 
St.  Sebastian,  St.  Laurence,  the  Holy 
Cross,  St.  Mary  the  Greater;  and  one  by 
Theodosius,  viz.  St.  Paul.     There  are  other 


86 


BASILIDIANS 


Tery  ancient  cliurches  in  Borne,  basilicas  in 
fonn  and  name,  but  not  cathedrals;  for 
example,  St.  Clement's  church,  supposed  to 
have  been  originally  the  house  of  the 
apostolical  oishop  of  that  name,  and  the 
most  ancient  existing  church  in  the  world. 
Several  Italian  churches  are  called  basilicas  ; 
at  Milan  especially  ;  often  more  than  one  in 
a  city.     (See  Cathedrals.') 

It  is  sometimes  said,  but  without  any 
certain  foundation,  that  some  of  the 
churches  in  England  with  circular  apsidal 
terminations  of  the  chancel,  (such  as  Kil- 
peck  and  Steetly,)  were  originally  Eoman 
basiUcas.  They  rather  derive  their  form 
from  the  Oriental  country  churches,  which 
are  uniformly  apsidal.  The  most  that  can 
be  said  of  them  is,  that  they  do,  in  some 
respects,  resemble  the  basilicas  in  arrange- 
ment. But  as  to  the  cathedrals  of  England, 
the  case  is  different :  and  since  old  Saxon 
or  Norman  churches  were  unquestionably 
local  developments  of  the  Eoman  style  in 
their  architectural  features,  it  is  possible 
that  they  derived  from  Eome  the  charac- 
teristics uniformly  observed  in  the  old 
basilicas.  The  conversion  of  the  apses  into 
sepulchral  chapels  for  shriues,  as  at  West- 
minster and  Canterbury,  as  superstition 
increased,  destroyed  the  ancient  arrange- 
ments. 

BASILIDIANS.  A  sect  of  the  Gnostic 
heretics,  the  followers  of  BasUides,  of  Alex- 
andria, a  disciple  of  Menander.  Cave  as- 
signs the  date  A.D.  112  to  him :  he  was 
certainly  alive  in  the  reign  of  Hadrian  (117- 
138),  as  Clemens  Alexandrinus  tells  us,  who 
knew  him  personally.  Between  St.  John's 
death  and  Hadrian's  reign,  only  20  years 
elapsed,  during  which  time  heresies  grew 
with  "  mushroom  growth."  Basilides 
taught  that  from  the  Unborn  Eather  was 
bom  his  Mind,  and  from  him  the  Word, 
from  him  Understanding  (^ippoinjcns'),  from 
-him  Wisdom  and  Power,  and  from  them 
Excellencies,  and  Princes,  and  Angels, 
who  made  a  heaven.  He  then  introduced 
a  successive  series  of  angelic  beings,  each 
set  derived  from  the  preceding  one,  to  the 
number  of  365,  and  each  the  author  of 
their  own  peculiar  heaven.  To  all  these 
angels  and  heavens  he  gave  names,  and 
assigned  the  local  situations  of  the  heavens. 
The  first  of  them  is  called  Abraxas,  a 
mystical  name,  containing  in  it  the  number 
365 :  the  last  and  lowest  is  the  one  which 
we  see ;  the  creators  of  which  made  this 
world,  and  divided  its  parts  and  nations 
amongst  them.  In  this  division  the  Jew- 
ish nation  came  to  the  share  of  the  prince 
of  the  angels  ;  and  as  he  wished  to  bring 
all  other  nations  into  subjection  to  his 
favourite  nation,  the  other  angelic  princes 
and  their  nations   resisted  him   and   his 


BASON 

nation.  The  Supreme  Father,  seeing 
this  state  of  things,  sent  his  first-begotten 
Mind,  who  is  also  called  Christ,  to  deliver 
those  who  should  believe  in  him  from  the 
power  of  the  creators.  He  accordingly 
appeared  to  mankind  as  a  man,  and  wrought 
mighty  deeds.  He  did  not,  however,  really 
suffer,  but  changed  forms  with  Simon  of 
Cyrene,  and  stood  by  laughing,  while 
Simon  suffered ;  and  afterwards,  being 
himself  incorporeal,  ascended  into  heaven. 
Building  upon  this  transformation,  Basili- 
des taught  his  disciples  that  they  might 
at  all  times  deny  him  that  was  crucified, 
and  that  they  alone  who  did  so  understood 
the  providential  dealings  of  the  Most 
High,  and  by  that  knowledge  were  freed 
from  the  power  of  the  angels,  whilst  those 
who  confessed  him  remained  under  their 
power.  Like  Saturninus,  however,  but  in 
other  words,  he  asserted  that  the  soul  alone 
was  capable  of  salvation,  but  the  body 
necessarily  perishable.  He  taught,  more- 
over, that  they  who  knew  his  whole  system, 
and  could  recount  the  names  of  the  angels, 
&c.,  were  invisible  to  them  all,  and  could 
pass  through  and  see  them,  without  being 
seen  in  return;  that  they  ought  likewise 
to  keep  themselves  individually  and  per- 
sonally unknown  to  common  men,  and  even 
to  deny  that  they  are  what  they  are ;  that 
they  should  assert  themselves  to  be  neither 
Jews  nor  Christians,  and  by  no  means  re- 
veal their  mysteries. — Epiph.  Mieres.  xxiv. 
c.  1 ;  Uhlhorn,  das  Basilidianische  System, 
1855  ;  Gnostic  Heresies,  by  Dean  Mansel ; 
Article  Basilides  in  Dictionary  of  Christian 
Biography;  Clemens  Alex.  Strom,  vi. ; 
Tertull.  de  Prsescrip.  xlvi. ;  Aug.  Hser.  iv.  ; 
Cave,  nist.  Liter.  Sasc.  Gnosticum. 

BASLE,  CONFESSION  OF.  This  was 
composed  by  certain  Protestants,  who  met 
together  at  Basle  in  1532,  under  the  feeling 
that  the  Confession  of  Augsburg  retained 
too  much  of  Catholic  doctrine  and  practice. 
It  was  remodelled  by  Bucer  and  the  Wur- 
temburg  theologians ;  and  became  the  Hel- 
vetic confession.  Afterwards,  in  1560,  it  was 
translated  into  Latin  by  BuUinger,  and  re- 
ceived generally  by  the  Protestant  Evangeli- 
cal Committees.  It  consisted  of  27  articles, 
treating  of  the  subjects  then  in  controversy, 
such  as  "original  sin,"  "free  will,"  "in- 
sufSciency  of  good  works,"  "the  invisible 
Church,"  "  no  succession  of  orders,"  "  sacra- 
ments," "exclusion  of  ornaments,  images, 
vestments,  &c.,  and  all  '  such  profane  ad- 
juncts.' " — ^Blunt,  Diet.  Sects,  p.  449 ; 
Stubbs'  Mosheim,  iii.  23. 

BASON  (or  BASIN)  [so  spelt  in  the 
sealed  books]  FOE  THE  OFPERTOEY. 
"  Whilst  the  sentences  for  the  Offertory  are 
in  reading,  the  deacons,  church-wardens, 
and  other  fit  persons  appointed  for  that 


BATH-KOL 

purpose,  shall  receive  the  alms  for  the  poor, 
and  other  devotions  of  the  people,  in  a 
decent  bason,  to  be  provided  by  the  parish 
for  that  purpose." — Rubric. 

It  is  clear  from  this  expression,  "  other 
devotions,"  that  our  reformers  did  not  in- 
tend to  interfere  with  the  ancient  destina- 
tion of  alms  in  the  holy  communion ;  but 
that  they  intended  that  all  our  gifts, 
whether  for  the  relief  of  the  poor — to  which 
indeed  the  Church  assigns  the  first  place — 
or  for  any  other  good  purpose,  should  be 
made  as  an  offering  to  God;  the  word 
devotions  signifying  an  act  of  giving  up  and 
dedicating  to  Almighty  God,  and  accom- 
panied with  prayer.     (See  Offertory.) 

BATH-KOL,  or  BATH-COL,  signifies 
Daughter  of  the  Voice.  It  is  a  name  by 
which  the  Jewish  writers  distinguish  what 
they  call  a  revelation  from  God,  after  verbal 
prophecy  had  ceased  in  Israel,  that  is,  after 
the  prophets  Haggai,  Zechariai  and  Malachi. 
The  generality  of  their  tradition  and  customs 
are  founded  on  this  Bath-Kol.  They  pre- 
tend that  God  revealed  them  to  their  elders, 
not  by  prophecy,  but  by  secret  inspiration, 
or  tradition:  and  this  they  call  the  Daughter 
of  the  Voice.  The  Bath-Kol,  as  Dr.  Prideaux 
shows  (Connect,  pt.  ii.  bk.  5),  was  a  fantas- 
tical way  of  divination,  invented  by  the 
Jews,  like  the  Sortes  Virgilianaj  among  the 
heathens.  "With  the  heathen  the  words  they 
happened  to  dip  upon,  in  opening  the  works 
of  Virgil,  were  the  oracle  by  which  they  prog- 
nosticated those  future  events  of  which  they 
desired  to  be  impressed.  In  like  manner  by 
the  Jews,  when  they  appealed  to  Bath- 
Kol,  the  next  words  which  they  heard  were 
considered  as  the  desired  oracle.  ,  Some 
Christians,  when  Christianity  began  to  be 
corrupted,  used  the  Scriptures  in  the  same 
manner  as  the  heathens  employed  the  works 
of  VirgiL  At  the  consecration  of  William, 
second  Norman  bishop  of  Norwich,  the  Bible, 
it  is  said,  was  "  dipped  "  into,  and  the  words 
"  not  this  man  but  Barabbas,"  came  up. — 
Du  Cange,  GZoss.  in  Sortes ;  Wharton,  Anglia 
Sacra. 

BATTLE,  or  more  properly,  BATTEL, 
Wager  of.  One  of  the  ancient  forms  of 
ordeal  or  appeal  to  the  judgment  of  God, 
in  the  old  Norman  courts  of  the  kingdom. 
(See  Ordeal.')  Under  certain  circumstances 
the  accused  at  a  trial  might  throw  down  his 
glove,  and  declare  his  willingness  to  defend 
his  innocence  with  his  body.  Both  accuser 
and  accused,  before  battle,  took  solemn  oath 
on  the  Gospel  that  their  cause  was  right, 
and  repeated  the  formula  "  So  help  me  God, 
and  His  saints."  In  "the  court  of  chivalry 
the  proceedings  were  somewhat  different. 
A  full  account  of  this  ordeal  is  given  by 
Lingard  (vol.  ii.  p.  288,  ed.  1837). 
Trial   by  battle  was   used  not   only  in 


BEADS 


87 


military  and  criminal  cases,  but  also  in  one 
kind  of  civil  action,  namely,  in  writs  of 
right,  which  were  not  to  determine  theyMS 
possessionis,  but  the  less  obvious  and  more 
profound  question  of  the  jus  proprietatis. 
In  the  simplicity  of  ancient  times,  it  was 
thought  not  unreasonable  that  a  matter  of 
such  diSBoulty  should  be  left  to  the  decision 
of  Providence  by  the  wager  of  battle.  In 
this  case  the  battle  was  waged  by  cham- 
pions, because,  in  civil  actions,  if  any  party 
to  the  suit  dies,  the  suit  must  abate,  or  end, 
and  therefore  no  judgment  could  be  given. 

The  last  trial  by  battle  that  was  allowed 
in  the  Court  of  Common  Pleas  at  West- 
minster was  in  the  thirteenth  year  of 
Queen  Elizabeth,  a.d.  1571,  as  reported 
by  Sir  James  Dyer ;  and  was  held  in  Tothill 
Fields  "non  sine  ms^na  juris  consulto- 
rum  pertui'batione."  There  was  after- 
wards one  in  the  Court  of  Chivalry  in  1631, 
and  another  in  the  county  palatine  of 
Durham  in  1628. 

The  Wager  of  Battle  was  accounted  ob- 
solete, until  it  was  unexpectedly  demanded 
and  admitted  in  1817,  in  a  case  of  murder, 
but  not  held ;  and  it  has  since  been  abolished 
by  Act  of  Parliament,  59  George  III.  c.  46. 

BAY.  (More  anciently  Severy.)  One 
whole  compartment  of  a  church  or  hall, 
which  comprises  several  similar  and  equal 
or  nearly  equal  divisions,  generally  marked 
off  by  pillars  with  an  arch  between  them. 
In  very  large  churches  there  are  generally 
one  or  more  openings  above  the  main  arches, 
into  the  space  between  the  vaulting  and  the 
outer  roof  of  the  aisles,  which  are  called  the 
triforium,  whether  there  are  three  or  more, 
or  fewer  openings,  like  unglazed  windows. 
Over  these  come  the  clearstory  windows  to 
give  light  into  the  church,  of  which  the 
tops  are  very  little  below  the  stone  vaulting 
of  the  nave,  if  there  is  any.  In  smaller, 
and  in  very  late  large  churches,  such  as 
Bath  Abbey,  there  is  no  triforium,  but 
larger  clearstory  windows  than  in  the 
earlier  styles. 

BEADS,  or  BEDES.  A  word  of  Saxon 
origin,  which  properly  signifies  prayers; 
hence  Bidding  the  Bedes  meant  desiring  the 
prayers  of  the  congregation,  and  from  the 
forms  used  for  this  purpose  before  the 
Keformation  is  derived  the  Bidding  of 
prayer,  prescribed  by  the  English  canons 
of  1603.  (See  Bidding  Prayer.)  From 
denoting  the  prayers  themselves,  the  word 
came  to  mean  the  little  balls  used  by  the 
Eomanists  in  rehearsing  and  numbeiing 
their  Ave-marias  and  Pater-nosters.  (See 
Eosary.)  A  similar  practice  prevails  among 
the  dei-vises  and  other  religious  persons 
throughout  the  East,  as  well  Mahometans 
as  Buddhists  and  other  heathens.  The 
ancient  form    of   the    Bedes,   or   Bidding 


88  BEATIFICATION 

Prayer,  is  given  in  Collier's  Eccl.  Bist. 
Becords,  No.  liv.,  vol.  ix.  p.  234,  ed.  18il, 
which  shows  that  our  present  Bidding 
Prayer  was  founded  on  that  model.    [H.] 

BEATIFICATION.  (See  Canonization.) 
In  the  Komish  Church,  the  act  by  which 
the  pope  declares  a  person  happy  after  death. 
Beatification  differs  from  canonization.  In 
the  former  the  pope  does  not  act  as  a  judge 
in  determining  the  state  of  the  beatified,  but 
only  grants  a  privilege  to  certain  persons  to 
Jionour  him  by  a  particular  religious  worship, 
without  incurring  the  penalty  of  super- 
stitious worshippers.  In  canonization  the 
pope  speaks  as  a  judge,  and  determines,  ex 
cathedra,  on  the  state  of  the  canonized.  It 
is  remarkable,  that  particular  orders  of 
monks  assume  to  themselves  the  power  of 
beatification. 

BEDDERN,  BEDERNA.  The  name 
still  retained  of  the  vicar's  college  at  York, 
and  of  the  old  collegiate  building  at  Beverley. 
Query,  whether  it  may  be  somewhat  the 
same  as  Bedehouse,  i.e.  an  hospital  ? — -Jebh. 

BEDE,  BED  A,  or  more  correctly  B  AED  A, 
commonly  called  the  Venerable  Presbyter, 
conunemorated  May  27.  He  was  bom  at 
or  near  Jarrow,  in  Northumberland,  and  edu- 
cated in  the  monastery  of  that  name,  and 
the  sister  monastery  of  Wearmouth.  He 
wrote  many  works,  chiefly  theological,  but 
the  most  celebrated  is  the  Historia  Ecdesi- 
astica  Oentis  Anglorum.  He  died  in  735.  [H.] 

BEGHARDS.  A  sect  of  media:val  here- 
tics. The  name  is  derived  from  the  old 
German  "  beggen,"  or  "  beggeren,"  and,  per- 
haps, at  one  time,  the  followers  were  at- 
tracted by  high  motives  in  leading  a  life  of 
honesty.  But  this  cannot  be  said  generally 
of  the  Beghards  in  the  middle  ages,  who 
were  mere  vagrants.  They  were  associated 
■with  the  Fraticelli  in  the  thirteenth  century, 
held  Antinomian  ideas,  and  had  the  gravest 
charges  of  immorality  laid  against  them. — 
Mosheim,  de  Beghardis,  et  Beguinabiis; 
Sfcubbs'  Soames'  Eccl.  Hist.  ii.  73,  206.  (See 
Adamites ;  Picards.) 

BEGUINES.  An  association  of  nuns, 
similar  "to  the  above.  The  name  is  derived 
either  from  St.  Begghe,  duchess  of  Brabant, 
in  the  seventh  century,  or  from  Lambert 
le  Begue,  a  priest  and  native  of  Liege, 
who  lived  in  the  twelfth  century ;  or,  as 
is  most  likely,  from  the  old  German  "  beg- 
gen." They  were  established  first  at  Liege, 
and  afterwards  at  Nivelle,  in  1207,  or,  as 
some  Say,  in  1226.  From  this  last  settle- 
ment sprang  tho  great  number  of  Beguin- 
ages,  which  are  spread  over  all  Flanders,  and 
which  have  passed  from  Flanders  into 
Germany.  In  the  latter  country,  some  of 
them  fell  into  extravagant  errors,  and  per- 
suaded themselves  that  it  was  possible  in 
the  present  life  to  attain  to  the  highest  per- 


BELLS 

fection,  even  to  impeccability,  and  a  clear 
view  of  God,  and  in  short,  to  so  eminent  a 
degree  of  contemplation,  that,  after  this, 
there  was  no  necessity  of  submitting  to  the 
laws  of  mortal  men,  civil  or  ecclesiastical. 
The  Council  of  Vienne,  in  1311,  condemned 
these  errors,  but  permitted  those  who  con- 
tinued in  the  true  faith  to  live  in  chastity 
and  penitence,  either  with  or  without  vows. 
There  stiU  subsist  many  communities  of 
Beguines  in  Flanders. — Hist,  des  Ord.  Rdig. 
viii.  c.  L 

BEL  AND  THE  DRAGON  (THE 
HISTORY  OF).  An  apocryphal  and  un- 
canonical  book  of  Scripture.  It  was  always 
rejected  by  the  Jewish  Church,  and  is  extant 
neither  in  the  Hebrew  nor  the  Chaldee  lan- 
guage, nor  is  there  any  proof  that  it  ever 
was  so.  St.  Jerome  gives  it  no  better  title 
than  "  the  fable  of  Bel  and  the  Dragon."  In 
the  old  Lectionary  of  the  Church  of  England, 
it  was  appointed  to  be  read,  but  in  the  new 
Lectionary  it  is  omitted. 

BELFRY.  The  place  where  the  bells 
are  hung;  sometimes  being  a  small  arch 
placed  on  the  gable  of  the  church,  •  some- 
times a  tower  or  turret.  The  belfries  were 
originally  detached  from  the  church,  as  may 
be  still  seen  in  many  places  in  Italy.  In- 
stances of  this  have  been  known  in  England, 
as  at  Chichester,  and  at  Salisbury  (the 
belfry  in  the  latter  place  was  destroyed  by 
Wyatt  the  architect,  with  multitudes  of 
other  antiquities  there  and  in  other  cathe- 
drals about  a  century  ago).  The  great 
central  towers  of  our  cathedrals  and  abbeys 
were  not  originally  constructed  for  bells,  but 
for  lanterns,  to  give  light  to  the  central 
portion  of  the  church.  The  bells  were  con- 
tained in  the  towers,  or  turrets,  at  the  west 
end,  or  at  the  angles  of  the  chmrch.  Many 
churches  had  more  than  one  bell  tower.  In 
Canterbury,  York,  Lichfield,  Lincoln,  Wells, 
St.  Paul's,  the  ring  of  bells  is  contained  in 
one  of  the  western  towers.  Among  bell- 
ringers  the  place  where  they  ring  is  called 
the  belfry,  and  the  place  where  the  beUs  are, 
the  bell-chamber. 

BELIEVERS  (morol,  or  Faithful).  A 
name  given  to  the  baptized  in  the  early 
Church,  as  distinguished  from  the  Catechu- 
mens. The  believer  was  admitted  to  all  the 
rites  of  Divine  worship,  and  instructed  in  all 
the  mysteries  of  the  Christian  religion. — 
Bingham,  bk.  i.  c.  3. 

BELLS.  Bells  of  a  small  size  are  very 
ancient,  but  larger  ones  are  of  a  much  later 
date.  The  lower  part  of  the  blue  robe  worn 
by  the  Jewish  high  priest  was  adorned  with 
pomegranates  and  gold  bells.  The  kings  of 
Persia  are  said  to  have  had  the  hem  of  their 
robes  adorned  in  like  manner.  But  bells  of 
that  kind,  and  the  only  ones  that  were 
known  for  many  centuries  after  that,  were 


BELLS 

made  of  thin  sheet  metal,  and  not  cast  of  a 
thick  brittle  metal  like  church  bells.  The 
origin  of  them  is  very  obscure.  They  are 
said  in  various  books  to  have  been  invented 
by  Paulinus,  bishop  of  Nola  in  Campania, 
about  400  A.D.,  but  that  is  not  very  proba- 
ble, though  he  may  have  first  used  them ; 
and  it  has  been  denied  by  other  writers,  but 
no  other  origin  has  been  discovered.  Large  bells 
existed  in  the  ninth  century  in  some  of  our 
abbeys.  For  a  long  time  there  were  no 
fixed  bell-foundries,  probably  from  the  diffi- 
culty of  carrying  heavy  bells  by  road  in 
early  times,  when  even  building  stones  were 
carried  by  pack-horses.  The  founders 
travelled  about  and  cast  bells  where  they 
were  wanted,  as  bell-founding  does  not  re- 
quire anything  like  the  heat  of  iron  smelt- 
ing ;  indeed,  you  can  melt  bits  of  bell  metal 
in  a  common  fire,  though  not  the  copper 
without  the  tin,  which  helps  it  to  fuse.  The 
hest  bell  metal  consists  of  thirteen  lbs.  of 
copper  to  one  of  tin,  and  with  no  other  in- 
gredient; silver  in  bells  is  a  mere  vulgar 
error  and  does  no  good,  and  all  inferior 
metals  are  mere  adulteration.  A  great  deal 
of  historical  and  other  matter  about  bells 
vpiL.  be  found  in  the  Eev.  H.  T.  Ellacombe's 
'  Bells  of  Devon,'  &c. ;  and  all  the  practical 
information  about  making  and  hanging  bells 
in  Sir  E.  Beckett's  'Clocks,  Watches  and 
Bells,'  together  with  the  particulars  of  the 
principal  large  bells  in  the  world,  and  the 
largest  peals  in  England,  and  instructions 
for  making  contracts  with  founders  to  secure 
■good  ones.  Modem  experience  does  not 
justify  the  notion  of  some  persons,  that 
better  bells  are  made  abroad  than  the  best 
that  are  made  here.  No  other  European 
country  rings  peals  of  bells  as  we  do,  though 
they  play  a  much  greater  number  of  small 
bells  in  chimes,  either  by  hand  or  by 
machinery.  The  best  number  for  a  peal  of 
.  veiy  heavy  bells  is  ten ;  it  is  impossible  to  hear 
twelve  bells  distinctly  of  any  weight  that 
can  be  rung.  All  peals  of  bells  sound  the 
notes  of  the  diatonic  scale,  and  therefore 
they  all  depend  upon  the  largest  bell  or 
tenor  of  the  peal.  Nevertheless,  they  are 
always  numbered  from  the  smallest  or 
treble.  Consequently,  a  peal  can  only  be 
increased  in  number  at  the  smaller  end, 
imless  some  of  the  middle  bells  are  changed 
to  make  the  notes  come  right :  except  that 
four  larger  ones,  but  no  less  number,  may 
be  added  to  make  a  jieal  of  six  into  ten. 
Six  are  the  lowest  number  that  make  a 
pleasant  peal,  but  five  wUl  just  do. 

It  may  be  useful  to  mention  that  there  is 
absolutely  no  cure  for  a  cracked  bell  but 
recasting  it,  for  which  the  invariable  price 
is  two  guineas  a  cwt.,  though  the  price  of 
new  ones  fluctuates  from  six  to  seven.  The 
heaviest  beU  in  England  is  the  new  one  of 


BELL-EINGING 


89 


St.  Paul's  Cathedral,  but  it  is  ill-placed  and 
hard  to  ring,  and  the  clock  does  not  strike 
on  it,  and  so  it  is  much  less  effective  than 
the  rather  smaller  and  partially  cracked  Big 
Ben  of  Westminster.  The  largest  ringing 
peal  also  is  in  the  same  cathedral ;  and  that 
and  Worcester  are  decidedly  the  finest. 
There  are  a  few  larger  in  town  halls,  but 
only  used  for  chiming  by  machinery.  Steel 
bells  were  tried  for  a  time,  being  cheaper 
than  bell  metal,  but  the  sound  is  very  in- 
ferior, and  in  fact  so  unpleasant  that  it  is 
absurd  to  spend  money  on  them.  Those 
who  contemplate  having  good  peals  of  bells 
in  new  churches  should  take  care  beforehand 
that  the  tower  is  built  large  enough  to  hold 
them  properly,  according  to  the  rules  given 
in  the  aforesaid  book  on  clocks  and  bells. 
It  wovdd  be  useless  to  go  into  more  de- 
tails here. 

The  incumbent  has  the  control  of  the 
bells,  as  has  been  several  times  decided,  but 
he  would  probably  not  be  allowed  to  stop 
their  being  properly  rung  for  service 
against  the  churchwardens,  as  the  rubric 
orders  at  least  one  to  be  rung  then.  But 
certainly  at  no  other  times  have  they  or 
their  ringers  any  right  of  entrance  to  the 
belfry.  Nor  may  the  bells  be  rung  at 
other  times  so  as  to  cause  a  nuisance.  An 
incumbent  when  inducted  locks  himself  in, 
and  rings  a  bell  as  a  sign  of  taking  pos- 
session.    [Gr.] 

BELL-KINGING,  CHANGES  AND 
CHIMES.  This  is  the  only  country,  unless 
the  art  has  travelled  to  America,  where 
bells  are  rung  round  in  full  swing  and  in  the 
regular  changes ;  which  again  mean  two 
different  things :  one  being  a  change  of  the 
order  of  the  bells  at  every  round  according 
to  certain  rules ;  and  the  other  a  mere  repe- 
tition of  the  same  order  or  change  for  a  con- 
siderable time  until  another  is  "  called."  In 
bell-ringing  language  bells  are  not  said  to 
be  rung  when  each  bell  is  only  tolled  or 
swung  just  enough  to  make  the  clapper 
strike  the  side  of  the  bell  on  which  it  is 
pulled.  When  only  one  bell  is  so  used  it  is 
called  tolhng ;  when  more  than  one  they  are 
said  to  be  chimed.  Generally,  they  are  only 
chimed  "  round  "  or  in  the  order,  one,  two, 
three,  &c. ;  and  bells  are  always  counted 
from  the  smallest,  or  treble,  up  to  the  largest, 
or  tenor,  which  is  contrary  to  the  order  of 
the  notes ;  and,  moreover,  the  notes  have 
always  to  be  fixed,  on  the  diatonic  scale, 
reckoning  from  the  tenor  or  lowest  note. 

Consequently  a  peal  can  only  be  added  to 
by  smaller  bells  above  the  treble,  and  not 
by  larger  below  the  tenor,  unless  some  of  the 
middle  ones  are  thrown  away,  because  other- 
wise the  half-notes  would  come  in  wrong 
places.  Taking  the  key  of  C  as  the  most 
convenient  to  illustrate  Isy,  though  peals  of 


90 


BELL-KINGING 


bells  may  be  in  any  key,  and  only  very 
large  ones  are  in  C,  a  peal  of  eight  stand 

thus :      ^     ^ 

12345678 
CBAGFEDC, 

the  bracketed  intervals  being  the  half  notes, 
which  must  always  be  in  those  places  of 
the  peal  reckoning  from  the  tenor.  You 
may  go  on  repeating  the  same  notes  an 
octave  higher  up  to  ten  or  twelve  bells,  the 
most  that  are  ever  used  for  ringing,  though 
not  for  chimes  that  play  tunes.  But  if 
you  add  even  one  bell  below,  which  must 
here  be  B  flat,  the  half-note  intervals  will 
all  come  wrong.  The  only  thing  to  do  is 
to  change  the  E  into  E  flat,  and  the  B 
above  into  B  flat,  and  either  discard  the  C 
treble,  as  nine  bells  are  never  used,  or  add 
a  new  D  treble  above  it.  It  is  important 
to  remember  this,  because  people  some- 
times get  a  lightish  peal  of  six  at  first,  and 
fancy  they  can  afterwards  add  a  heavier 
tenor  without  losing  any  of  the  first  peal. 
Sometimes,  too,  changing  the  middle  liells 
requires  a  larger  frame,  which  means  entire 
reconstruction  and  great  expense.  The 
passion  for  having  twelve  bells  is  a  mere 
piece  of  vanity,  for  adding  the  two  trebles 
always  spoils  the  sound  of  the  peal  and 
makes  it  much  more  difficult  to  ring  and 
hear  distinctly,  even  with  the  largest,  and 
consequently  slowest-swinging  bells  that 
can  be  rung. 

Though  chiming  is  seldom  accompanied 
with  changes,  except  when  it  is  done  by 
machinery,  a  few  changes  can  be  introduced 
every  now  and  then  by  good  hands,  but 
hardly  more  than  the  transposition  of  two 
bells  at  once,  and  must  be  dumb  for  the 
moment;  and  that  order  must  be  kept  up 
for  some  rounds,  whereas  in  ringing  every 
bell  can  change  its  place  every  time  if 
necessary.  We  must  now  explain  why  that 
is,  and  what  "  ringing  "  means  in  the  lan- 
guage of  the  belfry ;  which  word,  remember, 
means  the  ringing  chamber,  and  the  one 
where  the  bells  are  is  the  "bell-chamber," 
though  it  is  often  architecturally  called 
the  belfry,  when  it  is  not  necessary  to  dis- 
tinguish them ;  when  it  is,  the  others  are 
the  proper  names. 

In  order  to  "  ring "  a  beU,  you  have  to 
begin  by  toUing  it,  but  increasing  the  swing 
at  every  pull,  till  you  have  got  it  to  swing 
right  up,  so  that  the  mouth  is  upwards.  At 
a  certain  (i.e.  uncertain)  height  of  swing, 
the  clapper  seems  suddenly  to  change  its 
mind  if  you  watch  it,  and  to  strike  which- 
ever is  for  the  moment  the  upper  side  of  the 
bell,  running  after  it  faster  than  the  bell  itself 
goes.  The  place  where  it  begins  to  do  that 
depends  mathematically  on  the  distance  of 
the  clapper  pivot  below  the  pivots  or  "  gud- 
geons" of  the  bell.    And  all  that  can  be 


BELL-EINGING 

said  further  about  it  here  is  that  if  the  bell 
is  "  tucked  up  in  the  stock  "  (as  the  large 
bells  of  the  peal  must  be  to  some  extent) 
too  much,  they  always  "  rise  false,"  or  with 
the  clapper  on  the  low  or  following  instead 
of  the  upper  or  leading  side.  The  men  after- 
wards go  up  and  change  them,  and  the 
clappers  are  generally  kind  enough  to  re- 
main right  tOl  the  bells  "  fall "  again.  But 
why  do  not  the  bells  topple  over  when 
raised  upright,  for  of  course  they  will  not 
exactly  balance  ?  Because  there  is  a  strong 
arm  called  the  stay,  fixed  to  the  stock  and 
pointing  upwards  when  the  bell  is  down, 
and  therefore  down  when  it  is  up,  which,  if 
stopped  by  any  fixed  stop  at  the  bottom  of 
the  frame,  would  prevent  the  bell  from  going 
quite  up  to  the  vertical,  either  at  one  swing 
or  at  both.  That  would  not  do,  and  there- 
fore the  stop  itself  must  be  allowed  to  slide 
a  few  inches  when  the  stay  catches  it,  and 
it  is  thence  called  the  "  slider."  The  bell 
then  can  go  not  only  up  to  the  vertical,  but 
a  little  past  it,  and  will  stay  there  until  it 
is  pulled  off  again.  All  this,  and  the  ar- 
rangement of  the  rope  in  the  wheel,  must  be 
seen  to  be  understood  fully,  and  as  they  can 
be  seen  in  every  bell-chamber,  it  is  not  worth 
while  to  give  more  space  to  them  here. 
The  result  is  that  at  one  pull  of  the  rope 
this  "  sally,"  or  part  with  wool  woven  into 
it  to  make  it  soft  to  hold,  comes  ta  about 
the  same  level  when  the  bell  is  "up"  or 
"  set  at  the  forestroke''  as  when  it  is  down; 
but  at  the  other  pull,  or  "  set  at  the  back- 
stroke," the  sally  is  a  long  way  up,  nearly  to 
the  belfry  ceiling,  or  through  it  if  it  is  not 
high  enough,  and  you  have  only  the  tail  of 
the  rope  to  pull  by,  which  is  generally 
looped.  If  the  stay  breaks,  through  the 
ringer  having  pulled  too  hard,  and  not 
caught  the  sally  properly  or  held  the  tail  of 
the  rope,  the  bell  topples  over  and  pulls  the 
rope  away  altogether,  and  the  man  with  it 
if  he  does  not  let  go  immediately.  That  is 
the  danger  to  beginners,  for  nothing  looks 
easier  when  you  see  it  done,  and  nothing 
more  impossible  to  do  imtil  you  have  learnt 
it  gradually.  An  inexperienced  person 
cannot  tell  from  the  look  or  feel  of  the  ropes 
in  a  belfry  whether  the  bells  are  up  or 
down,  unless  they  are  left  at  the  back  stroke, 
as  they  always  should  be  if  left  set  at  all, 
and  therefore  no  such  person  should  meddle 
with  them  until  he  knows  that  they  are 
down — as  they  generally  are. 

This  power  of  setting  the  bells  is  the 
foundation  of  change-ringing.  Even  for 
ringing  round  the  small  bells  have  to  go 
higher  than  the  large  ones,  which  go 
slowest,  but  you  can  ring  round  without 
even  the  treble  going  quite  up.  In  fact,  in 
"  raising  and  falling  "  a  peal  in  order,  which 
is  the  most  pleasant  sound  and  the  most 


BELL-KINGING 

difficult  to  do  well,  the  bells  swing  in  suc- 
cession through  all  degrees,  the  small  ones 
always  going  highest  for  the  time  and 
"speaking  double"  soonest  in  rising  and 
longest  in  falling.  But  when  you  come  to 
changes,  it  means  that  the  second  bell  of 
every  pair  which  have  been  ringing  close 
together  before  has  to  be  stopped  for  a 
moment  by  being  set,  and  the  others  accele- 
,vated  by  being  pulled  again  before  it  is  quite 
up,  and  so  their  places  are  changed.  It 
must  not  be  supposed  that  they  are  allowed 
to  go  as  far  as  the  stay  and  slider  will  let 
them,  for  good  ringers  can  hold  them  just 
enough  overbalanced  to  pause  without  that, 
which  would  waste  labour  and  time  in 
pulhng  them  off  again. 

That  is  the  whole  mechanical  secret  of 
change-ringing,  but  the  musical  secret  in- 
volves a  variety  of  complicated  rules,  for 
real  changes,  changing  every  time  the  hells 
go  round.  It  would  take  far  too  much  space 
to  give  specimens  of  them  here,  and  speci- 
mens alone  would  be  of  no  use  to  those  who 
wish  to  learn  change-ringing,  as  many 
clergymen  do  with  great  benefit  to  them- 
selves in  the  exercise,  which  is  probably  the 
best  of  any,  except  that  it  is  not  in  the  open 
air — and  often  very  much  the  contrary — 
and  also  to  the  ringers.  The  best  books  on 
the  subject  are  by  two  eminent  ringers, 
Colonel  Troyte  and  Mr.  Jasper  Snowdon, 
who  supplies  them  from  Bank  Chambers, 
Leeds.  The  making  and  hanging  and  con- 
tracting for  bells,  and  forms  of  specifications 
for  them,  and  the  size  of  tenor  they  require, 
and  the  dimensions  of  the  largest  peals,  are 
fully  dealt  with  in  Sir  E.  Beckett's  book  on 
'  Clocks,  Watches,  and  Bells.'  Everyone  who 
has  learnt  arithmetic  knows  that  the  number 
of  possible  changes  on  n  bells  is  1  x  2  x  3 
X  n.  If  the  tenor  bell  is  kept  "  behind " 
or  last  at  every  change,  which  sounds  much 
the  best,  of  course  the  number  of  changes  is 
the  same  as  with  n  —  \  bells. 

Bell-chiming  by  machinery  worked  by 
one  man  is  a  capital  protection  against  re- 
bellious ringers.  The  bellfounders  and  bell- 
hangers  (who  sometimes  do  not  cast  bells 
themselves)  will  supply  the  different  ma- 
chines for  it.  It  is  enough  to  say  that  one 
machine  is  the  old-fashioned  barrel  with 
pin  lifting  levers  which  raise  hammers  out- 
side the  bells,  like  clock  hammers,  and  play 
any  tune  for  which  the  barrel  is  prepared ; 
and  the  other  has  a  number  of  smaller 
hammers  which  he  down  generally,  but  are 
pulled  up  to  strike  the  inside  of  the  beUs  by 
small  ropes  all  brought  down  into  a  frame 
in  the  belfry,  within  reach  of  one  man. 
This  was  invented  by  the  Eev.  H.  T.  Ella- 
combe,  the  author  of  the  '  Bells  of  Devon ' 
and  some  other  works,  who  was  a  belWnger 
at  the  age  of  nearly  ninety. 


BENEDICITE 


91 


The  playing  of  tunes  at  various  hours  of 
the  day  by  the  church  clock,  and  now  by 
the  clocks  of  sundry  town  halls  and  private 
houses,  on  heavy  peals  of  a  great  many 
bells,  has  nothing  particular  to  do  with 
church  services,  and  is  a  large  subject  by 
itself.  Such  machines  have  been  brought 
to  a  state  of  great  musical  perfection  of  late 
by  several  clockmakers,  and  for  them  also, 
and  the  comparison  in  other  respects  be- 
tween ^them  and  the  simple  old  kind,  we 
must  refer  to  the  same  book  on  Clocks  and 
Bells.     [G.] 

BELL,  BOOK,  AND  CANDLE.  Be- 
tween the  seventh  and  the  tenth  century, 
the  sentence  of  excommunication  was  at- 
tended with  great  solemnities.  The  most 
important  was  the  extinction  of  lamps  or 
candles  by  throwing  them  on  the  ground, 
with  an  imprecation,  that  those  against 
whom  the  curse  was  pronounced  might  be 
extinguished  or  destroyed  by  the  vengeance 
of  God.  The  people  were  summoned  to 
attend  this  ceremony  by  the  sound  of  a  bell, 
and  the  curses  accompanying  the  ceremony 
were  pronounced  out  of  a  book  by  the 
minister,  standing  in  a  balcony.  Hence 
originated  the  phrase  of  cursing  by  bell, 
book,  and  candle. 

BELGIC  CONFESSION  OF  FAITH. 
This  was  based  on  the  Helvetic  confession 
(see  Conf.  of  Basle),  and  was  composed  in 
the  Walloon  language,  by  Guy  de  Bres,  and 
afterwards  printed  in  French  in  1562.  It  is 
almost  in  unison  with  the  French  ot 
Galilean  confession,  and  differs  from  that 
of  Augsburg  in  many  ways,  especially  with 
regard  to  the  Lord's  Supper.  It  was  con- 
firmed by  the  Synod  of  Dort  in  1619. — 
Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  iii.  25 ;  Blunt's 
Doctrinal  Theol.  p.  107. 

BEMA.  The  name  of  the  bishop's  throne 
in  the  primitive  church,  or,  as  some  under- 
stand it,  the  whole  of  the  upper  end  of  the 
church,  containing  the  altar  and  the  apsis. 
This  seat  or  throne,  together  with  those  ot 
the  presbyters,  was  always  fixed  at  the 
upper  end  of  the  chancel,  in  a  semicircle 
beyond  the  altar.  For  anciently,  the  seats 
of  the  bishops  and  presbyters  were  joined 
together,  and  both  were  called  thrones. 
The  manner  of  their  sitting  is  related  by 
Gregory  Nazianzen  in  his  description  of  the 
church  of  Anastasia,  where  he  speaks  of 
himself  as  bishop,  sitting  upon  the  high 
throne,  and  the  presbyters  on  lower  benches 
on  each  side  of  him. — Euseb.  lib.  x.  c.  4; 
Nazian.  Somn.  Anasias.  vol.  ii. ;  Bingham, 
bk.  viii.  c.  6.    (See  Apsis  and  Cathedral.) 

BENATUEA.  A  stoup  for  "  holy  water." 

BENEDICITE.  A  canticle  used  at 
Morning  Prayer,  after  the  first  lesson; 
so  called  because,  in  the  Latin  version,  it 
begins  with  that  word.     It  is  also   called 


92 


BENEDICTINES 


"The  Song  of  the  Three  Children,"  be- 
cause Hananiah,  Mishael,  and  Azariah 
(whom  the  prince  of  the  eunuchs  named 
Shadi-aoh,  Meshach,  and  Abednego,  Dan. 
i.  7)  are  reported  to  have  sung  it  in  the 
burning  fiery  furnace,  into  which  they  were 
cast  by  order  of  Nebuchadnezzar  for  ad- 
hering steadfastly  to  their  God  (Dan.  iii. 
19),  and  in  which  God  preserved  them  in 
a  miraculous  manner  (ver.  27). 

The  Benedicite  is  mentioned  by  several  of 
the  fathers  as  being  used  in  the  services 
of  the  church.  St.  Chrysostom  speaks  of  it 
■as  "  that  marvellous  song,  sung  everywhere 
throughout  the  world"  (tom.  iv.  p.  520). 
Athanasius  refers  to  it  (Be  Virg.  p.  122, 
ed.  1698),  and  at  the  Council  of  Toledo  the 
clergy  were  especially  enjoined  to  sing  it 
every  Lord's  day  (Cone.  Tolet.  iv.  14).  In 
the  old  Galilean  ritual  it  was  sung,  as  at 
present,  between  the  lessons  (Mabillon,  de 
Lit.  Oall.  lib.  ii.  p.  108).  The  rubric  in 
the  Prayer  Book  of  1549  ordered  its  use 
in  Lent  only,  but  this  was  altered  in  1552, 
and  the  Benedicite  may  be  used  instead  of 
the  Te  Deum  at  any  time. — Bingham,  bk. 
xiv.  c.  ii.  sec.  6. ;  Blunt's  P.  B.  11-15. 

BENEDICTINES.  An  order  of  monks 
who  profess  to  follow  the  rule  of  St.  Bene- 
dict, who  died  about  a.d.  543.  I.  The  rule  of 
Benedict  was  very  strict.  The  monks  were 
to  rise  at  2  for  vigils,  and  pass  the  time  till 
daybreak  in  meditation  and  reading.  At 
sunrise  matins ;  then  four  hours  labour ; 
then  two  hours  reading;  then  dinner  and 
private  reading  till  2 .  30 ;  then  prayer ; 
afterwards  labour  till  vespers.  Twenty-four 
psalms  were  to  be  chanted  every  day. 
Their  labour  was  agriculture  or  mechanical 
trades,  as  the  superior  thought  fit ;  none 
could  choose  for  himself,  for  personal  liberty 
was  renounced.  Their  food  was  of  the 
simplest,  and  no  conversation  was  allowed 
at  meals.  They  might  not  go  abroad  but 
two  together.  No  one  could  receive  a 
present,  or  have  any  correspondence  with 
an  outsider,  without  the  abbot's  inspection. 
The  abbot,  elected  by  common  suflrage  of 
the  brotherhood,  was  despotic,  and  could 
inflict  punishment,  or  pronounce  expulsion 
on  any  recalcitrant  or  erring  brother.  (See 
the  Bule,  Eospinian,  tom.  iv.  pp.  202-222.) 
But  the.  strictness  of  this  rule  was  relaxed, 
and  the  Benedictines  became  luxurious,  and 
took  part  in  political  and  civil  affairs.  They 
gained  immense  power,  and  numbered 
amongst  their  ranks  many  eminent  persons. 
Pope  John  XXII.,  who  died  in  1354,  after 
an  exact  inquiry,  found,  that,  since  the  first 
rise  of  the  order,  there  had  been  of  it  twenty- 
four  popes,  near  200  cardinals,  7000  arch- 
bishops, 15,000  bishops,  15,000  abbots  of 
renown,  above  4000  saints,  and  upwards  of 
37.000  monasteries.     There  have  been  like- 


BENEDIOTION 

wise  of  this  order  twenty  emperors  and  ten 
empresses,  forty-seven  kings,  and  above  fifty 
queens,  twenty  sons  of  emperors,  and  forty- 
eight  sons  of  kings,  about  one  hundred 
princesses,  daughters  of  kings  and  emperors, 
besides  dukes,  marquises,  earls,  countesses, 
&c.,  innumerable.  This  order  has  produced 
a  vast  number  of  eminent  authors  and  other 
learned  men.  Eabanus  set  up  the  school  of 
Germany.  Alcuinus  founded  the  university 
of  Paris.  Dionysius  Bxiguus  perfected  the 
ecclesiastical  computation.  Guido  improved 
the  scale  of  music,  and  Sylvester  the 
organ.  They  boast  to  have  produced 
Anselm,  Ildephonsus,  Venerable  Bede,  &c. 
There  are  nuns  likewise  who  follow  the 
order  of  St.  Benedict :  among  whom  those 
who  call  themselves  mitigated,  eat  flesh 
three  times  a  week,  on  Sundays,  Tuesdays, 
and  Thursdays ;  the  others  observe  the  rule 
of  St.  Benedict  in  its  rigour,  and  eat  no  flesh 
unless  they  are  sick. 

IL  The  time  when  this  order  came  into 
England  is  well  known,  for  in  596  Gregory 
the  Great  sent  hither  Augustine,  prior  of 
the  monastery  of  St.  Andrew  at  Eome, 
with  several  other  Benedictine  monks.  Au- 
gustine became  archbishop  of  Canterbury ; 
and  the  Benedictines  founded  several  mon- 
asteries in  England,  as  also  the  metropolitan 
church  of  Canterbury.  But  the  Benedictine 
Order,  in  the  modern  sense  of  the  word, 
was  not  completed  until  the  reformation  of 
the  second  Benedict,  and  Benedict  of  Aniane 
died  in  821.  Before  Dunstan's  time  we  may 
doubt  the  existence  anywhere  in  England 
of  the  Benedictine  rule  in  its  completeness. 
(Hook's  Archbishops,  vol.  i.  pp.  34,  35.) 
Afterwards  it  increased  rapidly,  and  the 
Benedictines  were  the  most  extensive  and 
powerful  order  in  England.  All  the  cathe- 
dral convents,  with  the  exception  of  the 
Augustinian  monastery  of  Carlisle,  were  of 
this  order,  as  were  four  out  of  the  five  that 
were  converted  into  cathedrals  by  Henry 
VIIL,  viz.  Gloucester,  Oxford,  Peterborough, 
and  Chester :  and  aU  the  mitred  abbeys, 
with  the  exception  of  Waltham  and  Ciren- 
cester, which  were  Augustinian.  In  Ireland 
they  yielded  in  importance  and  numbers  to 
the  Augustinians.  They  v/ere  the  great 
patrons  of  church  architecture  and  of  learn- 
ing in  England.  The  chief  branches  of  the 
Benedictine  order  in  England  were  the 
Cluniacs,  founded  by  Bernon,  abbot  of  Gig- 
niac,  in  913 ;  and  the  Cistercian,  founded 
by  Robert,  abbot  of  Molgme,  at  Citeaux  in 
Burgundy,  in  1098.  (See  Cluniac  Monks, 
and  Cistercians.') 

BENEDICTION.  A  solemn  act  of 
blessing  performed  by  the  bishops  and 
priests  of  the  Church. 

I.  Of  Persons.  In  the  Jewish  Church, 
the  priests,  by  the  command  of  God,  were 


BENEDICTION 

to  bless  the  people,  by  saying,  "  The  Lord 
bless  thee,  and  keep  thee.  The  Lord  make 
Ms  face  to  shine  upon  thee,  and  be  gracious 
unto  thee.  The  Lord  lift  up  his  counte- 
nance upon  thee,  and  give  thee  peace." 

In  the  Christian  Church  bishops  and 
priests  only  are  allowed  to  pronounce  bene- 
diction. It  was  a  general  custom  in  the 
primitive  Church  to  bow  the  head  at 
receiving  the  benediction  of  a  bishop,  and 
the  emperors  themselves  did  not  refuse  to 
comply  with  it. — Bingham,  bk.  ii.  c.  9,  sec.  1. 
In  the  Western  Churches  a  benediction 
was  pronounced  immediately  before  the 
communion,  after  the  Lord's  Prayer.  This 
is  called  in  the  Galilean  Missals  "  Benedictio 
populi."  (MabiUon,  de  Lit.  i.  c.  4.)  In  the 
Council  of  Toledo  certain  priests  were 
censured,  for  communicating  after  the  Lord's 
Prayer,  without  giving  the  benediction  to 
the  people.     (JJonc.  Tolet.  iv.  17.) 

In  the  Church  of  England  several  forms 
of  blessing  are  used,  agreeing  with  the 
particular  ofSoe  of  which  they  form  a  part. 
Of  the  ordinary  benediction  at  the  end  of 
the  communion  office,  the  first  clause  (taken 
from  Phil.  iv.  7)  was  appointed  in  1548 ;  the 
second,  which  resembles  "  Blessings  "  given 
in  Hermann's  Consultation,  and  the  Anglo- 
Saxon  offices,  was  added  in  1549. 

Other  forms  of  blessing,  or  modifications 
of  the  above,  may  be  found  in  the  offices 
for  Confirmation,  Matrimony,  and  Visitation 
of  the  Sick.  The  benediction  at  the  end  of 
the  Communion  Service  must  be  said  by  the 
bishop,  if  he  be  present. 

IL  Of  Things,  (i.)  Benediction  of  the 
Font.  An  ancient  ceremony ;  also  a  name 
given  formerly  to  the  consecration  of  the 
water  at  baptism.  According  to  the  custom 
in  the  Western  Churches  the  water  was  not 
blessed  at  every  administration,  but  once  a 
month ;  our  present  practice  accords  with 
the  Eastern  custom.  (See  Baptism,  Blunt's 
P.  B.  209 ;  Bingham,  bk.  xv.  6.) 

(ii.)  In  the  Roman  and  Greek  Churches, 
and  among  other  Christians  of  the  East, 
water,  with  a  mixture  of  salt,  is  blessed  by  a 
priest,  according  to  a  set  form  of  benediction. 
The  holy  water  is  used  to  sprinkle  persons, 
things  and  places,  and  is  regarded  with  great 
reverence. 

(iiL)  In  the  Eoman  Church,  on  Holy 
Thursday,  the  officiating  priest  blesses, 
consecrates,  and  exorcises,  three  sorts  of  oils. 
The  first  is  that  used  in  extreme  unction ; 
the  second  that  of  the  Chrysma ;  the  third 
that  of  the  Catechumens ;  ending  with  this 
salutation,  Ave  sanctum  oleum,  "  Hail  holy 
oil ! "  after  which  the  new-made  holy  oils 
are  carried  in  procession  into  the  sacristy. — 
Piscara,  Praxis  Cerem. 

(iv.)  On  Easter-eve  is  performed  the 
ceremopy  of  blessing  the  new  fire.     At  the 


BENEDICTUS 


93 


ninth  hour,  the  old  fire  is  put  out,  and  at 
the  same  time  an  acolyth  lights  the  new 
fire  without  the  church.  The  officiating 
priest,  with  his  attendants,  walks  in  process 
sion  to  the  place  where  the  ceremony  is  to 
be  performed.  The  fire  is  sprinkled  with 
holy  water  and  solemnly  blessed. 

(v.)  The  principal  use  of  this  holy  fire, 
among  the  Eomanists,  is  to  light  therewith 
the  Paschal  taper ;  which  likewise  receives 
its  benediction,  or  blessing,  by  the  priest's 
putting  five  grains  of  incense,  in  the  form 
of  a  cross,  into  the  taper.  This  blessed 
taper  must  remain  on  the  gospel-side  of 
the  altar  from  Easter-eve  to  Ascension-day. 
— Baudry,  Manual.  Cerem.  Fast.  lib.  iii. 
144 ;  Piscara,  Praxis  Cerem. 

(vi.)  On  certain  occasions  the  pope  used 
to  bless  a  banner  or  sword,  which  he  would 
give  to  those  who  were  engaged  in  any 
cause  in  which  he  was  interested.  Thus 
William  the  Conqueror  received  together 
with  a  papal  bull  a  banner  which  had  been 
blessed. 

On  the  eve  before  Christmas,  the  pontiff 
blesses  a  sword,  and  ducal  hat  enriched  with 
precious  stones.  This  he  sends  as  a  present 
to  some  prince,  for  whom  he  has  a  particular 
affection,  or  some  great  -general,  who  has 
deserved  it  by  fighting  against  the  enemies 
of  the  Church.  Pope  Pius  II.  sent  the  hat 
and  sword  to  Lewis  XI. 

(vii.)  But  one  of  the  most  extraordinary 
benedictions  of  this  kind  is  that  of  bells ;  in 
the  performance  of  which  there  is  a  great 
deal  of  pomp  and  formality.  (See  Bells.) 
Martene  has  printed  a  great  number  of 
benedictional  services  (de  Ant.  Bit.  Eccles. 
lib.  ii),  which,  it  is  remarked,  a  priest  is 
competent  to  perform,  though  it  is  more 
proper  that  a  bishop,  if  possible,  should 
officiate  thereat.  (See  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit. 
Ecd.  Ang.  i.  ccovi.) )  [H.] 

BENEDICTUS.  The  Latin  for  "  bless- 
ed," which  is  the  first  word  in  one  of  the 
hymns  to  be  said  or  sung  after  the  second 
lesson  in  the  Morning  Service  of  the  Church. 
The  Benedictus  is  taken  from  St.  Luke  i., 
from  the  68th  to  the  72nd  verse,  being  part  of 
the  song  of  Zacharias  the  priest,  concerning 
his  son  John  the  Baptist,  who  was  to  be 
the  forerunner  of  Christ,  but  was  then  only 
in  his  infancy.  The  Benedictus  has  followed 
the  lesson,  at  least  since  820,  when  it  is 
mentioned  by  Amalarius.  It  was  exclusively 
appointed  in  1549 ;  the  alternative  of  Jubi- 
late being  added  in  1552,  to  avoid  repetition. 
"  The  Church  hath  appointed  two  songs  of 
praise  and  thanksgiving  to  be  used,  either 
of  them  after  each  lesson,  but  not  so 
indifferently  but  that  the  former  practice  of 
exemplary  Churches  and  reason  may  guide 
us  in  the  choice.  For  the  "Te  Deum," 
"Benedictus,"   "Magnificat,"  and  "Nunc 


94 


BENEFICE 


Dimittis,"  being  the  most  expressive  jubi- 
lations and  rejoicings  for  the  redemption  of 
the  world,  may  be  said  more  often  than  the 
test,  especially  on  Sundays  and  other  festi- 
vals of  our  Lord." — Bishop  Sparrow. 

BENEFICE,  in  the  ecclesiastical  sense 
of  the  word,  means  a  church  endowed  with 
a  revenue  for  the  performance  of  Divine 
service,  or  the  revenue  itself  assigned  to  an 
ecclesiastical  person,  by  way  of  stipend  for 
the  service  he  is  to  do  that  church. 

As  to  the  origin  of  the  word,  we  find  it 
as  follows,  in  Alcefs  liitual :  "  This  word 
was  anciently  appropriated  to  the  lands, 
which  kings  used  to  bestow  on  those  who 
had  fought  valiantly  in  the  wars ;  and  was 
not  used  in  this  particular  signification,  but 
during  the  time  that  the  Goths  and  Lom- 
bards reigned  in  Italy,  under  whom  those 
fiefs  were  introduced,  which  were  peculiarly 
termed  Benefices,  and  those  who  enjoyed 
them,  Beneficiarii,  or  vassals.  For  not- 
withstanding that  the  Romans  also  bestowed 
lands  on  their  captains  and  soldiers,  yet 
those  lands  had  not  the  name  of  Benefices 
appropriated  to  them,  but  the  word  bene- 
fice was  a  general  term,  which  included  aU 
kinds  of  gifts  or  grants,  according  to  the 
ancient  signification  of  the  Latin  word.  In 
imitation  of  the  new  sense,  in  which  that 
word  was  taken  with  regard  to  fiefs,  it 
began  to  be  employed  in  the  Church,  when 
the  temporalities  thereof  began  to  be  divided, 
and  to  be  given  up  to  particular  persons,  by 
taking  them  out  of  those  of  the  bishops. 
This  the  bishops  themselves  first  introduced, 
purposely  to  reward  merit,  and  assist  such 
ecclesiastics  as  might  be  in  necessity.  How- 
ever, this  was  soon  carried  to  greater  lengths, 
and  at  last  became  unlimited,  as  has  since 
been  manifest  in  the  clericate  and  the 
monasteries.  A  benefice  therefore  is  not 
merely  a  right  of  receiving  part  of  the 
temporalities  of  the  Church,  for  the  service 
a  person  does  it ;  a  right,  which  is  founded 
upon  the  gospel,  and  has  always  subsisted 
since  the  apostolic  age;  but  it  is  that  of 
enjoying  a  part  of  the  temporalities  of  the 
Church,  assigned  and  determined  in  a 
special  form,  so  as  that  no  other  clergy- 
man can  lay  any  claim  or  pretension  to  it. 
— And  in  this  age  it  is  not  barely  the  right 
of  enjoying  part  of  the  temporalities  of  the 
Church;  but  is  likewise  a  fixed  and  per- 
manent right,  in  such  a  manner  that  it 
•devolves  on  another,  after  the  death  of  the 
incumbent ;  which  anciently  was  otherwise ; 
for,  at  the  rise  of  benefices,  they  were  in- 
dulged to  clergymen  only  for  a  stated  time, 
■or  for  life ;  after  which  they  reverted  to  the 
Church." 

It  is  not  easy  to  determine  when  the 
effects  of  the  Church  were  first  divided.  It 
is  certain  that,  till  the  fourth  century,  all  the 


BENEFIT 

revenues  were  in  the  hands  of  the  bishops, 
who  distributed  them  by  their  CEconomi  or 
stewards;  and  they  consisted  chiefly  in 
alms  and  voluntary  contributions.  When 
the  Church  came  to  have  inheritances,  part 
of  them  were  assigned  for  the  maintenance 
of  the  clergy,  of  which  we  find  some  foot- 
steps in  the  fifth  and  sixth  centuries ;  but 
the  allotment  seems  not  to  have  been  a 
fixed  thing,  but  to  have  been  absolutely 
discretional,  till  the  twelfth  century. 

Benefices  are  divided  by  the  canonists 
into  simple  and  sacerdotal.  The  first  sort 
lays  no  obligation,  but  to  read  prayers,  sing, 
&c.  Such  kind  of  beneficiaries  are  canons, 
chaplains,  chanters,  &c.  The  second  is 
charged  with  the  cure  of  souls,  the  guidance 
and  direction  of  consciences,  &c.  Such  are 
rectories,  vicarages,  &c.  The  canonists  Uke- 
wise  specify  three  ways  of  vacating  a  bene- 
fice ;  viz.  de  jure,  de  facto,  and  hy  tlie  sen~ 
tence  of  a  judye.  A  benefice  is  void  de  jure 
when  a  person  is  guilty  of  crimes,  for  which 
he  is  disqualified  by  law  to  hold  a  benefice ; 
such  are  heresy,  simony,  &c.  A  benefice  is 
void  both  de  facto  and  de  jure,  by  the  na- 
tural death,  or  resignation,  of  the  incum- 
bent, or  by  his  being  instituted  to  any  other 
preferment  which  by  Act  of  Parliament  or 
common  law  vacates  it.  Lastly,  a  benefice 
is  vacated  hy  sentence  of  the  judge,  when  the 
incumbent  is  deprived. 

The  Church  distinguishes  between  dig- 
nities and  benefices.  The  former  title  is 
only  applicable  to  bishoprics,  deaneries, 
archdeaconries,  and  prebends:  the  latter 
comprehends  all  ecclesiastical  preferments 
under  those  degrees ;  as  rectories  and  vicar- 
ages.   (See  Plurality.) 

BENEFICIARIES,  or  BENEPICIATL 
The  inferior,  non-capit\ilar  members  of 
cathedrals,  &c.,  were  so  called  in  many 
Churches  abroad;  as  possessing  a  benefice 
or  endowment  in  the  Church.  They  very 
much  corresponded  to  our  minor  canons  and 
vicars  choral,  &c. — Jebb. 

BENEFIT  OP  CLERGY.  The  privi- 
legium  clericale,  or,  in  common  speech,  the 
benefit  of  the  clergy,  had  its  origin  from 
the  pious  regard  paid  by  Christian  princes . 
to  the  Church  of  Christ.  The  exemptions 
which  they  granted  to  the  Church  were 
principally  of  two  kinds  :  1.  Exemption  of 
places  consecrated  to  religious  ofiices  from 
criminal  arrests,  which  was  the  foundation 
of  sanctuaries.  (See  Sanctuary,  Asylum.) 
2.  Exemptions  of  the  persons  of  the  clergy 
from  criminal  process  before  the  secular 
magistrate  in  a  few  particular  cases,  which 
was  the  true  origin  and  meaning  of  the 
privilegium  clericale.  Originally  the  law 
was  held  that  no  man  should  be  admitted 
to  the  privilege  of  the  clergy  but  such  as 
had  the  habitum  et  tonsuram  dericalem. 


BEEEANS 

But,  in  process  of  time,  a  much  wider  and 
more  comprehensive  criterion  was  estab- 
lished, every  one  that  could  read  being 
accounted  a  clerk  or  clericus,  and  allowed 
the  benefit  of  clerkship,  whether  in  holy 
orders  or  not. 

BEREANS.  An  obscure  sect  of  se- 
ceders  from  the  Scottish  establishment. 
They  took  their  name  from  those  Bereans 
"  who  received  the  word  with  all  readiness 
of  mind,  and  searched  the  Scriptures  daily, 
whether  those  things  were  so."  (Acts  xvii. 
11.)  They  allow  no  authority  to  the  Church, 
tut  only  look  to  the  Scriptures,  which  they 
interpret  according  to  their  own  ideas. 

BEREPELLARII.  In  the  collegiate 
church  of  Beverley  the  seven  inferior 
clergymen,  ranking  next  after  the  preben- 
daries, were  so  called.  The  origin  of  the 
name  is  unknown ;  though  it  appears  from 
ancient  records  that  it  was  a  popular  and 
vulgar  one ;  their  proper  designation  being 
Heclores  Chori ;  that  is,  a  sort  of  minor 
canons.  They  were  also  called  Personss. — 
Dugdale's  Monasticon,  ed.  1830,  vi.  1307. 

BEKENGARIANS.  A  denomination, 
in  the  eleventh  century,  which  adhered  to 
the  opinions  of  Berengarius,  archdeacon  of 
Angers,  the  learned  and  able  opponent  of 
Lanfranc,  whose  work  has  been  in  part 
recovered,  and  was  printed  a  few  years 
since  at  Berlin.  "It  was  never  my  asser- 
tion," says  he,  "  that  the  bread  and  wine 
on  the  altar  are  only  sacramental  signs. 
Let  no  one  suppose  that  I  affirm  that  the 
bread  was  not  become  the  body  of  Christ 
from  being  simple  bread  by  consecration 
on  the  altar.  It  plainly  becomes  the  body 
of  Christ,  but  not  the  bread  which  in  its 
matter  and  essence  is  corruptible,  but  in 
as  far  as  it  is  capable  of  becoming  what  it 
was  not,  it  becomes  the  body  of  Christ, 
but  not  according  to  the  manner  of  the 
production  of  his  very  body,  for  that  body, 
once  generated  on  earth  so  many  years 
ago,  can  never  be  produced  again.  The 
bread,  however,  becomes  what  it  never 
was  before  consecration,  and  from  being 
the  common  substance  of  bread,  is  to  us 
the  blessed  body  of  Christ."  His  fol- 
lowers, however,  did  not  hold  to  his  doc- 
trines, which,  in  themselves,  were  a  Catho- 
lic protest  against  Roman  doctrines. — Cave, 
Hist.  Literar.  Ssr.  EUdebrand.  For  life 
of  Berengarius  see  Mabillon,  tom.  ix.  p.  7  sea. 

BETROTHAL.  The  pledging  of  troth 
or  truth,  between  man  and  woman.  In 
olden  times  betrothals  were  often  made 
long  before  marriage  could  take  place. 
According  to  the  Roman  law  "sponsalia" 
or  betrothals,  could  take  place  after  the 
parties  were  seven  years  of  age ;  and  in  the 
Church  there  were  distinct  and  separate 
ceremonies  for    betrothals,   and   marriage. 


BIBLE 


95 


In  the  Code  of  Justinian  several  rules  vpith 
regard  to  betrothal  are  laid  down  {Cod. 
Justin,  lib.  v.  4,  &o.),  chiefly  relating  to  the 
age,  and  free  will  of  the  betrothal.  When 
the  contract  was  made,  pledges  of  future 
marriage  were  given,  which  were  called 
"ArrjB,"  or  "donationes  six)nsalitia3."  A 
ring  also  was  given,  and  a  formal  kiss,  and 
joining  of  hands  in  the  presence  of  witnesses. 
{Cod.  Theod.  lib.  iii.  v.,  ed.  1665,  vol.  i.  p. 
267.) 

French  betrothals  were  used  in  England 
up  to  the  time  of  the  Reformation,  but 
now  the  betrothal  and  marriage  are  joined 
in  one  office.  In  the  marriage  service  the 
words  of  betrothal  are  almost  identical  with 
the  term  in  the  Sarum  Use,  one  sentence 
being  omitted — "if  holy  Chyrche  it  wol 
ordeyne."  In  the  York  Use  the  words 
"for  fairer,  for  laither"  were  said  before 
"  for  beter,  for  wors " :  the  word  laither, 
from  the  old  English  "  lath,"  hateful,  (with 
which  perhaps  is  connected  the  French 
word  "  laid,"  ugly,  meaning  loathlier,  or 
uglier).  The  ancient  ceremonies  with 
regard  to  betrothal  are  given  by  Bingham, 
bk.  xxii.  c.  3. 

BIBLE.  (See  Scripture.')  The  name 
applied  by  Christians  by  way  of  eminence 
to  the  sacred  volume,  in  which  are  con- 
tained the  revelations  of  God.  The  names 
and  numbers  of  the  canonical  books  will  be 
found  under  the  word  Scripture. 
I.  Ancient  History. 
II.  Early  English  versions. 

III.  Later  Translations. 

IV.  Irish  and  Welsh. 

V.  Division  into  chapters. 

I.  The  Bible  has  been  handed  down  to  us 
in  four  principal  languages,  Hebrew,  Greek, 
Syriac,  and  Latin;  but  Hebrew  was  the 
language  of  the  Old  Testament  generally, 
except  Ezra,  ch.  iv.  v.  8,  ch.  vi.  v.  19,  and 
ch.  vii.  w.  12-27 ;  Jeremiah,  ch.  x.  v.  11 ; 
and  Daniel,  ch.  ii.  v.  4 — ch.  vii.,  which  were 
in  Chaldee. 

(a)  Whether  the  art  of  writing  had  its 
origin  in  the  communication  of  God  with 
Moses  on  Mount  Sinai,  is  doubtful.  Some 
imagine  that  the  passage,  Gen.  xxiii.  17, 
is  an  actual  abridgment  of  the  conveyance 
of  the  field  of  Ephron  made  to  Abraham. 
It  is  certainly  not  improbable  that  the 
patriarchs  might  have  compiled  records  of 
their  time,  and  that  b3''  inspiration ;  and 
that  Moses  might  collect  these,  as  Ezra 
did  in  after  times.  And  this  is  argued  by 
some  fi'om  a  supposed  difference  of  style. 
Moses  himself  was  expressly  directed  to 
write  by  way  of  record ;  a  custom  which 
continued  under  the  Judges  and  the  Kings, 
some  of  the  latter  of  whom  collected  and 
arranged  the  books  then  existing ;  as  it  is 
clear  Hezekiah   did  the   proverbs  of  Solo- 


9(5 


BIBLE 


mon.  The  propliesies  of  Jeremiali,  we 
know,  were  publicly  read ;  and  when  Ezra 
made  his  collection,  the  number  of  copies 
was  great,  and  the  difference  existing  be- 
tween them  is  supposed  to  form  the 
marginal  readings,  amounting  in  all  to 
840.  It  was  after  his  time  that  transla- 
tions began  to  be  made.  Ezra  brought 
together  all  the  ancient  books,  and  changed 
the  old  characters  that  had  been  used,  to 
those  of  his  own  time.  He  also  wrote  the 
later  historical  books,  and  in  his  time,  or 
shortly  after,  was  added  the  last  inspired 
book  of  prophecy — that  of  Malachi.  It  is 
impossible  to  say  how  widely  MS.  copies 
of  the  Scriptures  were  spread  abroad ;  but 
it  is  interesting  to  note  that  between  a  very 
ancient  Hebrew  MS.  written  on  goat-skins, 
and  brought  from  Malabar,  and  other  nearer 
copies,  only  a  few  (40)  slight  variations 
were  found.  Dr.  Kennicott  some  years  ago 
collated  700  MSS.  of  the  Hebrew  Bible : 
but  none  of  them  date  from  before  our 
Lord.  Many  other  copies  of  the  seventh 
and  eighth  centuries  have  since  been  dis- 
covered. "  Accurate  notes  "  and  "  expla- 
nations "  in  Chaldee  of  the  Hebrew  Bible 
were  made  at  a  very  early  date  (30  B.C.) 
by  learned  Hebrew  doctors  who  desired 
both  to  instruct  the  people,  and  to  preserve 
the  integrity  of  the  text.  (See  Masora, 
Targum.) 

(0)  All  the  books  of  the  Old  Testament 
were  translated  into  Greek  about  300  years 
before  Christ.  According  to  Josephus,  this 
translation  was  made  by  order  of  Ptolemy 
Philadelphus  (b.c.  277),  and  was  carried 
out  by  72  learned  men,  who  at  enormous 
expense  (said  to  have  been  £136,000)  were 
formed  into  a  sort  of  college  for  the  purpose 
in  the  isle  of  Pharos,  near  Alexandria. 
Hence  it  is  called  the  Septuagint,  as  a 
general  term,  though  the  translators  were 
two  in  number  over  the  70.  (Jos.  Ant.  bk. 
xii.  c.  2.)  This  was  probably  the  version 
used  by  the  Apostles,  as  it  is  often  quoted 
in  the  New  Testament;  and  it  was  also 
that  used  by  the  early  Christian  writers. 
The  oldest  MS.  copies  known  in  the 
Greek  of  the  Old  and  New  Testament 
(though  none  are  quite  complete)  are  those 
in  the  British  Museum,  called  the  Alex- 
andrine MS.  of  the  fifth  century,  in  the 
Vatican  library  at  Kome  of  the  fourth 
century,  and  a  third,  probably  of  the  fourth 
century,  discovered  partly  in  1844,  partly  in 
1859,  by  Professor  Tisohendorf,  which  is 
deposited  in  the  Imperial  library  at  St 
Petersburg.  There  are  four  principal 
modern  editions :  the  Complutensian,  a.d. 
1514-1517  ;  the  Aldine,  1518 ;  the  Eoman 
of  Sixtus  v.,  1587 ;  and  Grabbe's,  printed  at 
Oxford,  1707-1720.  A  list  of  the  Ancient 
Greek  MS.  of  the  New  Testament  in  uncial 


BIBLE 

letters  is  given  in  Wordsworth's  Greek 
Testament,  vol.  i.  p.  xxxvi.  The  Cursive 
MSS.  amount  to  more  than  500. 

(y)  The  Syriac,  called  the  Peschito,  i.e. 
simple  literal  version  of  the  Old  and  New 
Testament,  is  of  great  antiquity,  dating  as 
far  back  as  perhaps  the  beginning  of  the 
second  century.  (See  Peschito.)  Syriac  was 
the  language  used  in  upper  Mesopotamia  and 
Asia  Minor,  and  was  very  similar  to  the  dia- 
lect spoken  by  the  Jews  in  our  Lord's  time. 
(8)  The  Gothic  version  was  made  by 
Dlphilas,  Bishop  of  the  Goths  in  348. 
Although  he  was  an  Arian,  it  is  free  from 
all  taint  of  that  heresy.  The  late  Cardinal 
Mai  when  examining  some  palimpsests  at 
Milan,  found  some  Gothic  writing  under  that 
of  one  of  the  codices.  Pursuing  his  investi- 
gations, his  labours  resulted  in  the  discovery 
of  almost  the  whole  of  the  thirteen  epistles 
of  St.  Paul,  and  parts  cf  the  gospels. — 
Dictionary  of  the  Bible,  p.  1620. 

(f )  While  the  Septuagint  was  the  common 
version  of  the  Bible  for  the  Jews  and  early 
Christians,  and  three  of  the  gospels  and  the 
epistles  were  certainly  written  in  Greek, 
which  was  the  general  language  of  the 
educated  classes,  there  was  also  a  Latin 
version  current  in  the  second  century. 
There  is  no  doubt  that  for  the  common 
people  of  Italy,  translations  of  portions  of 
the  Bible  were  made  into  Latin.  But  there 
were  also  a  great  nmnber  of  other  trans- 
lations, Persian,  Coptic,  Armenian,  &c.,  &c., 
with  regard  to  which  we  must  refer  to  the 
exhaustive  articles  on  "  Versions  "  by  Tre- 
gelles  and  others  in  the  Dictionary  of  the 
Sible.  The  Latin  translations  were  brought 
together  by  St.  Jerome,  who  revised  them, 
and,  when  necessary,  added  his  own  trans- 
lations. This,  which  is  called  the  Vulgate, 
was  after  his  time,  and  in  the  mediseval 
times,  chiefly  nsed;  and  by  the  Eoman 
Church  is  considered  of  the  highest  autho- 
rity. From  it  were  made  the  early  trans- 
lations into  English,  up  to  and  including 
that  of  Wyclif. 

II.  In  England  the  Bible  has  always  been 
regarded  with  the  greatest  reverence,  and  at 
a  very  early  date  parts  of  it  were  translated 
into  the  vernacular.  Bede  speaks  of  laymen 
as  well  as  monks  being  engaged  in  studying 
the  Scriptures. 

Cffidmon,  a  lay  brother  in  the  monastery  of 
Streaneshaloh  or  Whitby,  in  the  7th  cen- 
tury, made  a  metrical  version  into  English 
of  Genesis  and  Exodus,  and  cast  the  chief 
incidents  of  our  Lord's  life,  the  descent  of 
the  Holy  Spirit,  and  the  teaching  of  the 
apostles,  into  a  kind  of  lyric  poem.  (Bede, 
iv.  24.)  It  has  been  asserted  by  Archbishop 
Ussher,  but  without  proof,  that  a  large  part 
of  the  Bible  was  translated  by  Eadfrith, 
bishop  of  Lindisfarne  in  710,  and  a  little 


BIBLE 

earlier  by  Aldhelm,  bishop  of  Sherborne. 
King  Alfred  began  a  version  of  the  Psalms 
which  was  not  finished,  and  the  four  chapters 
of  Exodus  xx.-xxiil.,  together  with  the  letter 
of  the  Council  of  Jerusalem,  Acts  xv.  23-29, 
in  English,  form  the  preface  to  his  code  of 
law. 

Abbot  ^Ifric,  called  Grammaticus  (circa 
1005),  made  an  abridged  translation  of  the 
first  seven  books  of  the  Old  Testament,  and 
of  the  Book  of  Job. 

An  ancient  MS.  discovered  by  Sir  Thomas 
PhiUips  in  the  library  of  Worcester 
Cathedral,  of  the  twelfth  century,  refers  to 
Alcuin  as  a  translator  of  the  Bible.  "  He," 
says  the  writer,  "translated  the  books 
Genesis,  Exodus,  &c.,  and  through  them 
taught  the  people  in  English,  with  the 
bishops  (of  whom  a  list  is  given).  But  now," 
it  is  mournfully  added, "  it  is  another  people 
who  teach  our  folke,  and  they  perish." 
"The  hole  Byble,"  says  Sir  T.  More,  "was 
longe  before  Wicklifife's  daies,  by  vertuose 
and  well  learned  men  translated  into  the 
English  tongue,  and  .  .  .  well  and  reverently 
read."  There  are  grounds,  however,  for 
doubting  Sir  T.  Move's  assertion.  For  no 
such  translations  of  the  entire  Scripture  are 
extant.  "  No  traces  of  them  appear  in  any 
contemporary  writer  "  (Plumptre  in  Diet,  of 
Bible,  p.  1665),  nevertheless  Archbishop 
Cranmer  in  his  preface  to  the  Bible  (a.d. 
1540)  speaks  of  it  as  having  been  "  trans- 
lated and  redde  in  the  Saxones  tonge,  which 
at  that  time  was  our  mother  tongue."  In 
the  Bodleian  Library,  the  British  Museum 
and  elsewhere,  numerous  old  copies  of  por- 
tions of  the  Bible  translated  into  the  ver- 
nacular are  to  be  found. 

III.  Wyclif  translated  the  Bible,  about 
1360,  from  the  Vulgate.  His  object  was  to 
restore  the  Bible  to  the  people  in  their  own 
language,  for  it  had  been  "  withholden  from 
them."  The  New  Testament,  Dr.  Water- 
land  thinks,  was  translated  by  Wyclif 
himself,  while  the  Old  Testament  was 
copied  from  previous  translations.  There  are 
some  beautiful  copies  of  Wyclif's  Bible  to 
be  seen  in  the  Bodleian  Library,  and  in  the 
British  Museum ;  and  the  whole  of  Wyclif  s 
translation  has  been  published  at  Oxford, 
(1851).  J.  de  Trevisa,  who  died  about 
1398,  is  also  said  to  have  translated  the 
whole  Bible ;  but  whether  any  copies  of  his 
translation  are  remaining,  does  not  appear. 
The  first  printed  Bible  in  our  language  was 
that  translated  by  W.  Tyndal,  assisted  by 
Miles  Coverdale,  printed  abroad  in  1525; 
but  most  of  the  copies  were  bought  up  and 
burnt  by  Bishop  Tunstal  and  Sir  Thomas 
More.  Of  this  edition  but  two  copies  are 
known  to  exist,  one  of  which  was  discovered 
by  Archdeacon  Cotton,  in  St.  Paiil's  Library. 
It  only  contained  the  New  Testament,  and 


BIBLE 


97 


was  revised  and  republished  by  the  same 
person  in  1530.  The  prologues  and  prefaces 
added  to  it  reflect  on  the  bishops  and  clergy ; 
but  this  edition  was  also  suppressed,  and  the 
copies  burnt.  In  1532,  'I'yndal  and  his 
associates  finished  the  whole  Bible,  except 
the  Apocrypha,  and  printed  it  abroad. 
Several  editions  were  brought  out  after  this, 
until  Tyndal's  noble  labours  were  closed  by 
a  martyr's  death  in  1536.  An  independent 
translation  based  partly  on  Tyndal's,  and 
four  other  versions,  had  meanwhile  been  made 
by  Miles  Coverdale  and  printed  at  Zurich  in 
1535.  It  was  succeeded  by  another  trans- 
lation executed  in  1537.  The  printing  of  the 
book  was  begun  abroad,  and  carried  as  far  as 
the  end  of  Isaiah,  at  which  point  it  was  taken 
up  and  continued  by  the  English  printers 
Grafton  and  Whitchurch.  It  was  the  work  of 
John  Rogers,  superintendent  of  an  English 
Church  in  Germany,  and  the  first  martyr  in 
the  reign  of  Queen  Mary.  He  translated  the 
Apocrypha,  and  revised  Tyndal's  translation, 
comparing  it  with  the  Hebrew,  Greek,  Latin, 
and  German,  and  adding  prefaces  and  notes 
from  Luther's  Bible.  He  dedicated  the 
whole  to  Henry  VIII.  under  the  borrowed 
name  of  Thomas  Matthew ;  whence  this 
has  been  usually  called  Matthew'' s  Bible,  and 
licence  was  obtained  for  publishing  it  in 
England,  by  the  favour  of  Archbishop 
Cranmer,  and  the  Bishops  Latimer  and 
Shaxton.  In  1539  appeared  a  revised 
edition  of  Matthew's  Bible  by  Eichaid 
Taverner;  but  the  first  Bible  printed 
by  authority  in  England,  and  publicly 
set  up  in  churches,  was  Ty^idal's  version, 
revised  and  compared  with  the  Hebrew, 
and  in  many  places  amended,  probably 
by  Miles  Coverdale,  afterwards  Bishop 
of  Exeter;  and  examined  after  him  by 
Archbishop  Cranmer,  who  added  a  preface 
to  it;  whence  this  was  called  Cranmer's 
or  the  Great  Bible.  It  was  printed  in 
1539  by  Grafton  and  Whitchurch,  and 
again  by  Whitchurch,  (some  copies  have 
"  Richard  Grafton,")  and  published  in 
1540 ;  and,  by  a  royal  proclamation,  every 
parish  was  obliged  to  set  one  of  the  copies 
in  their  church,  under  the  penalty  of  forty 
shillings  a  month.  Yet,  two  years  after,  the 
Popish  bishops  obtained  its  suppression  by 
the  king.  It  was  restored  under  Edward  VI., 
suppressed  again  under  Queen  Mary's  reign, 
and  restored  again  in  the  first  year  of  Queeu 
Elizabeth,  and  a  new  edition  of  it  given, 
1562,  printed  by  Harrison.  Some  English 
exiles  at  Geneva,  in  Queen  Mary's  reign, 
viz.  Goodman,  Gilbie,  Sampson,  Cole, 
Whittingham,  and  Knox,  made  a  new  trans- 
lation, printed  there  in  1560,  the  New 
Testament  having  been  printed  in  1557 ; 
hence  called  the  Geneva  Bible,  containing 
the  variations  of  readings,  marginal  annota- 

i{ 


98 


BIBLE 


tions,  &c.,  on  account  of  wbicli  it  was  much 
Tallied  by  the  Puritan  party  in  that  and  the 
following  reigns.     Coverdale  has  also  been 
supposed  to  have  had  a  part  in  this  version ; 
but  from  what  is  known  of  his  movements,  it 
appears  doubtful  whether  he  can  have  been 
,  concerned  in  it.     The  first  edition  of  this 
version  was  for  many  years  the  most  popular 
one  in  England,  as  its  numerous  editions 
may  testify.    After  the  appearance  of  King 
James's  translation,  the  use  of  it  gradually 
declined;    although    thirteen    reprints    in 
whole  or  in  part  were  issued  between  1611 
and  1617.     A  fondness  also  for  its  notes 
still  lingered ;   and  we  have  several  instances 
of  their  being  attached  to  editions  of  the 
royal  translation,  one  of  which  kind  was 
printed  so    lately  as   1715.       Archbishop 
Parker  resolved  on  a  new  translation  for  the 
public  use  of  the  Church ;  and  engaged  the 
bishops  and  other  learned  men  to  take  each 
a  share  or  portion ;  these,  being  afterwards 
joined    together  and  printed,   with    short 
annotations,    in  1568,    in    large  folio,  by 
Eichard  Jugge,  made,  what  was  afte wards 
called,  the  Great  English  Bible,  and  com- 
monly the  Bishop's  Bille.    In  1569  it  was 
also  published  in  octavo,  in  a  small  but  fine 
black  letter;  and  here  the  chapters  were 
divided  into  verses,  but  without  any  breaks 
for  them,  in  which  the    method    of   the 
Geneva  Bible  was  followed,  which  was  the 
first  English  Bible  where  any  distinction  of 
verses  was  made.     It  was  afterwards  printed 
in  large  folio,  with  corrections,  and  several 
prolegomena,  in  1572  ;  this  is  called  Mattliew 
jParker's  Bible.    The  initial  letters  of  each 
translator's  name  were  put  at  the  end  of  his 
part ;  ex.  gr.  at  the  end  of  the  Pentateuch, 
W.  E.  for  William  Exon ;  that  is,  William 
(Alley),  Bishop  of  Exeter,  whose  allotment 
ended  there ;  at  the  end  of  Samuel,  R.  M. 
for  Richard  Menevensis,  or  Richard  (Davies), 
Bishop  of  St.  David's,  to  whom  the  second 
allotment  fell,  and  so  with  the  rest.    The 
archbishop  overlooked,  directed,  examined, 
and  finished  the  whole.     This  translation 
was  used  in  the  churches  for  forty  years, 
though  the  Geneva  Bible  was  more  read  in 
private  houses,  being  printed  above  twenty 
times  in  as  many  years.    After  the  transla- 
tion of  the  Bible  by  the  bishops,  two  other 
private  versions  had  been  made  of  the  New 
Testament ;  the  first  by  Laurence  Thompson, 
from  Beza's  Latin  edition,  -with  the  notes  of 
Peza,  published  in   1582,  in  quarto,   and 
afterwards  in  1589,  varying  very  little  from 
the    Geneva    Bible;    the    second    by    the 
Romanists  at  Rheims,  in  1584,  called  the 
Rhemish    Bible,  or   Rhemish    translation. 
These  translators  finding  it  impossible  to 
keep  the  people  from  having  the  Scriptures 
in  their  vulgar  tongue,  resolved  to  give  a 
version  of  their  own,  as  favourable  to  their 


BIBLE 

cause  as  might  be.  It  was  printed  on  large 
paper,  with  a  fair  letter  and  margin.  One 
complaint  against  it  was,  its  retaining  a 
multitude  of  Hebrew  and  Greek  words  un- 
translated, for  want,  as  the  editors  express 
it,  of  proper  and  adequate  terms  in  the 
English  to  render  them  by ;  as  the  words 
azymes,  tunike,  holocaust,  prepuce,  pasche, 
&c. :  however,  many  of  the  copies  were 
seized  by  Queen  Elizabeth's  searchers,  and 
confiscated;  and  Thomas  Cartwright  was 
solicited  by  Secretary  Walsingham  to  refute 
it ;  but  after  some  progress  had  been  made  in 
the  work.  Archbishop  Whitgift  prohibited  his 
proceeding  further,  judging  it  improper  that 
the  doctrine  of  the  Church  of  England  should 
be  committed  to  the  defence  of  a  Puritan. 
He  appointed  Dr.  Fulke  in  his  place,  who 
refuted  the  Rhemists  with  great  spirit  and 
learning.  Cartwright's  Refutation  was  also 
afterwards  published  in  1618  under  Arch- 
bishop Abbot. 

About  thirty  years  after  their  New 
Testament,  the  Roman  Catholics  published 
a  translation  of  the  Old,  at  Douay,  1609  and 
1610,  from  the  Vulgate,  with  annotations,  so 
that  the  English  Roman  Catholics  have  now 
the  whole  Bible  in  their  mother  tongue; 
though  it  is  to  be  observed,  they  are  for- 
bidden to  read  it  without  a  licence  from  their 
superiors  ;  and  it  is  a  curious  fact,  that  there 
is  not  an  edition  of  the  Bible  which  does  not 
lie  under  the  ban  of  one  or  of  all  the  popes, 
most  of  them  being  in  the  Index  Expur- 
gatorius.  King  James  bore  to  the  Geneva 
version  an  inveterate  hatred,  on  account  of 
the  notes,  which  he  charged  as  partial, 
untrue,  seditious,  &c.  The  Bishops'  Bible, 
too,  had  its  faults.  The  king  frankly  owned 
that  he  had  seen  no  good  translation  of  the 
Bible  in  English ;  but  he  thought  that  of 
Geneva  the  worst  of  all.'  The  authorized 
English  Bible  was  that  which  proceeded  from 
the  Hampton  Court  conference  in  IGOS-i ; 
where,  many  exceptions  being  made  to  the 
Bishops'  Bible,  King  James  gave  order  for  a 
new  one :  not,  (as  the  preface  expresses  it,) 
"for  a  translation  altogether  new,  but  to 
make  a  good  one  better, or, of  many  good  ones, 
one  principal  good  one."  Fifty-four  learned 
men  were  appointed  to  this  office  by  the  king, 
as  appears  by  his  letter  to  the  archbishop, 
dated  1604 ;  which  being  three  years  before 
the  translation  was  entered  upon,  it  is 
probable  seven  of  them  were  either  dead,  or 
had  declined  the  task ;  since  Fuller's  list  of 
the  translators  makes  but  forty-seven,  who, 
being  ranged  under  six  divisions,  entered  on 
their  province  in  1607.  These  were  all  men 
of  "  ponderous  "  learning,  headed  by  Bishop 
Andrewes,  who  was  master  of  Latin,  Greek, 
Hebrew,  Chaldee,  Syriac,  and  fifteen  modern 
languages.  It  was  published  in  1611  in  fol. 
by  Barker,  with  a  dedication  to  James,  and  a 


BIBLE 

iearned  preface ;  and  is  commonly  called 
King  James's  Bible.  After  this,  all  the 
other  versions  gradually  dropped,  and  fell 
into  disuse,  except  in  the  epistles  and  gospels 
in  the  Common  Prayer  Book,  which  were 
retained  according  to  the  hishop's  trans- 
lation till  the  alteration  of  the  liturgy  in 
1661.  See  for  a  full  list  of  the  editions  of 
the  English  Bible,  Archd.  Cotton's  Liit  of 
the  Editions  of  the  English,  Bible,  &c. ;  Pre- 
face to  the  English  Hexapla  (Bagster) ;  and 
-generally  for  the  subject  of  this  article,  The 
Bible  in  tlie  Church,  by  Canon  Westcott  ; 
Introduction  to  the  Criticism  of  the  Neio 
Test.,  by  Dr.  Scrivener  (3rd  ed.) ;  Article 
on  "  Versions  "  in  Smith's  Diet,  of  the  Bible." 

Some  editions  of  the  Bible  have  received 
strange  names,  as  the  "Breeches  Bible," 
^1599),  caQed  from  the  word  breeches  being 
■used  for  the  coverings  Adam  and  Eve  used 
after  the  fall.  The  "  Wicked  Bible  "  was 
the  name  assigned  to  the  Bible  printed  by 
Barker  and  Lucas  in  1631.  The  word 
"  not "  was  omitted  in  the  seventh  command- 
ment. Laud  had  the  printers  heavily  fined 
for  this  mistake. 

In  Eehruary,  1870,  the  Convocation  of 
Canterbury  determined  on  a  revision  of  the 
Authorized  Version  of  the  Bible,  and  in  the 
following  May  two  companies  were  formed, 
one  for  the  Old,  the  other  for  the  New  Testa- 
jnent,  and  certain  principles  and  rules  were 
drawn  up  for  their  guidance.  These  were, 
shortly,  that  there  should  be  as  few  altera- 
tions as  possible;  that  the  expression  of  these 
should  be  limited  as  much  as  possible  to  the 
language  of  the  Authorised  and  earlier  Eng- 
lish Version ;  that  the  headings  of  chapters 
and  pages,  paragraphs,  italics  and  punctua- 
tion should  be  revised;  that  reference,  when 
considered  desirable,  should  be  made  to 
divines  or  literary  men,  at  home  and  abroad ; 
-that  the  text  to  be  adopted  should  be  that  for 
which  the  evidence  is  decidedly  preponder- 
ating. Other  details  were  laid  down  as  that 
each  portion  should  be  gone  over  twice; 
and  no  change  in  the  text  should  be  made 
unless  it  was  adopted  by  two-thirds  of  those 
present.  The  co-operation  of  American 
scholars  was  invited,  and  two  committees 
were  formed  in  America  to  act  with  the  two 
EngUsh  companies.  The  various  portions  of 
the  two  revisions  were  sent  over  as  they 
were  completed,  and  received  the  criticism 
of  the  American  committees.  When  the 
revised  version  of  the  New  Testament  was 
finished,  it  was  sent  over  as  a  whole,  and 
the  Americans  pointed  out  certain  alterations 
■which  they  still  deemed  would  be  advisable. 
These  are  printed  at  the  end  of  the  book, 
and  are  not  very  numerous.  The  first  is  to 
omit  "  S."  (i.e.  saint)  at  the  headings  of  the 
pages,  and  from  the  title  of  tne  Gospels; 
another  is  to  change  all  the  old-fashioned 


BIBLE 


99 


words  for  modern  forms.  The  work  of 
revision  was  begun  June  22,  1870 ;  and  the 
New  Testament  was  issued  Nov.  11,  1880. 
The  revisors  state  that  they  had  faithfully 
and  consistently  endeavoured  to  follow  the 
rules  given.  One,  only,  they  had  been 
unable  to  observe,  which  was  with  regard  to 
headings  of  chapters  and  pages.  These  they 
judged  it  best  to  omit.  The  revision  of  the 
Old  Testament  was  published  in  May,  1885, 
and  copies  presented  by  the  Archbishop  of 
Canterbury  to  the  Queen  and  Prince  of 
Wales.  To  enter  into  the  subject  of  the  new 
translation  either  of  the  Old  or  New  Testa- 
ment, would  be  to  enter  into  a  controversy 
not  possible  in  a  Dictionary. 

IV.  The  New  Testament  was  translated  into 
Irish  in  the  sixteenth  century.  Nicholas 
Walsh,  chancellor  of  St.  Patrick's,  and  John 
Kearney,  treasurer  of  the  same  cathedral, 
began  this  work  in  1573.  In  1577  Walsh 
was  appointed  Bishop  of  Ossory,  but  still 
proceeded  in  his  undertaking,  till  he  was 
murdered  in  1585.  Some  years  before  this, 
Nehemiah  Donnellan  (who  was  archbishop 
of  Tuam  in  1595)  had  joined  Walsh  and 
Kearney  in  their  undertaking.  This  trans- 
lation was  completed  by  William  O'Donnell, 
or  Daniel,  successor  of  Donnellan  in  the 
archiepiscopal  see,  and  published  in  1603. 
Bishop  Bedell  procured  the  Old  Testament 
to  be  translated  by  Mr.  King,  who  being 
ignorant  of  the  original  languages,  executed 
it  from  the  Enghsh  version.  Bedell  revised 
it,  comparing  it  with  the  Hebrew,  the  LXX., 
and  the  Italian  version  of  Diodati.  He 
supported  Mr.  King,  during  the  undertaking, 
with  his  utmost  ability,  and,  when  the 
translation  was  finished,  would  have  printed 
it  at  his  own  house,  if  he  had  not  been  pre- 
vented by  the  troubles  in  Ireland.  'I'his 
translation  (together  with  Archbishop 
Daniel's  version  of  the  New  Testament)  was 
printed  in  London  in  1685,  at  the  expense 
of  the  celebrated  Eobert  Boyle. — King's 
Primer  of  the  Church  History  of  Ireland ; 
Home's  Introduction  to  the  Holy  Scriptures. 
The  Welsh  version  (the  New  Testament 
only)  was  pubhshed  in  the  sixteenth  century. 
The  Act  of  5  Eliz.  c.  28,  directed  that  the 
Bible  and  Prayer  Book  should  be  translated 
into  Welsh;  committing  the  direction  of 
this  version  to  the  four  Welsh  bishops.  The 
translators  were,  Thomas  Huet,  precentor 
of  St.  David's,  Richard  Davies,  bishop  of  St. 
David's,  and  William  Salesbury.  it  was 
printed  in  1567.  The  former  edition  was 
revised,  and  the  Old  Testament  translated, 
chiefiy  by  William  Morgan,  bishop  of 
Llandaff,  afterwards  of  St.  Asaph.  This  was 
printed  in  1588,  and  was  revised  by  Eichard 
Parry,  bishop  of  St.  Asaph,  and  reprinted  in 
1620  :  the  basis  of  all  subsequent  editions. — 
Home's  Introd. 


100 


BIDDING 


The  Manx  version  of  the  Bible  was  begun 
by  the  exertions  of  Bishop  Wilson,  by  whom 
the  Gospel  of  St.  Matthew  only  was  printed. 
His  successor.  Bishop  Hilderly,  had  the  New 
Testament  completed  and  printed  between 
the  years  1756  and  1760.  The  Old  Testa- 
ment was  completed  two  days  before  his 
death  in  1772.— Home's  Jntrod. ;  Butler's 
Life  of  Bishop  Hilderly. 

By  the  80th  canon, "  a  Bible  of  the  largest 
volume  "  is  one  of  those  things  which  the 
churchwardens  are  bound  to  provide  for 
every  parish  church. 

V.  The  most  ancient  copies  of  the  Bible 
are  written  in  capital  letters  without  any 
breaks  between  the  words,  and  with  no 
verses  or  chapters. 

The  division  of  the  Scriptures  into 
chapters,  as  they  are  at  present,  took  place 
in  the  middle  ages.  Some  attribute  it  to 
Stephen  Langton,  archbishop  of  Canterbury, 
in  the  reigns  of  John  and  Henry  III.  But 
the  real  author  of  this  invention  was  Hugo 
de  Sancto  Care,  commonly  called  Hugo 
Cardinalis,  from  his  being  the  first  Dominican 
raised  to  the  degree  of  Cardinal.  This 
Hugo  flourished  about  the  year  1240.  He 
wrote  a  Comment  on  the  Scriptures,  and 
projected  the  first  Concordance,  which  is 
that  of  the  Latin  Vulgate  Bible.  As  the 
intention  of>  this  work  was  to  render  the 
finding  of  any  word  or  passage  in  the  Scrip- 
tures more  easy,  it  became  necessary  to 
divide  the  book  into  sections,  and  the  sections 
into  subdivisions.  These  sections  are  the 
chapters  into  which  the  Bible  has  been 
divided  since  that  time.  But  the  subdivision 
of  the  chapters  was  not  then  in  verses  as  at 
present.  Hugo  subdivided  them  by  the 
letters  a,  b,  c,  d,  e,  f,  g,  which  were  placed 
in  the  margin  at  an  equal  distance  from  each 
other,  according  to  the  length  of  the  chapters. 
About  the  year  1445,  Mordecai  Nathan,  a 
famous  Jewish  Kabbi,  improved  Hugo's  in- 
vention, and  subdivided  the  chapters  .into 
verses,  in  the  present  manner.     [H.] 

BIDDING  PRAYEE:  originaUy  bidding 
of  prayer.  The  custom  of  bidding  prayers 
is  very  ancient,  as  may  be  seen  in  St.  Chry- 
sostom's  and  other  liturgies,  where  the 
biddings  occur  frequently,  and  are  called 
AUocutiones,  ■irpo(T<pa>vri(T(is.  (See  Beads.') 
The  formulary  which  the  Church  of  England, 
in  the  55th  of  the  canons  of  1603,  directs  to 
be  Used  before  all  sermons,  lectures,  and 
homilies,  is  called  the  Bidding  Prayer,  be- 
cause in  it  the  preacher  is  directed  to  hid  or 
exhort  the  people  to  pray  for  cert^n  specified 
objects. 

The  55th  canon  of  the  Convocation  of 
1603  is  as  follows:  "Before  all  sermons, 
lectures,  and  homilies,  the  preachers  and 
ministers  shall  move  the  people  to  join 
with  tliem  in  prayer,  in  this  form,  or  to  this 


BIGAMY 

effect,  as  briefly  as  conveniently  they  may : 
'  Ye  shall  pray  for  Christ's  Holy   Catholic 
Church,  that  is,  for  the  whole  congregation 
of   Christian  people  dispersed    throughout 
the  whole  world,   and   especially  for    the 
Churches  of  England,  Scotland,  and  Ireland. 
And  herein  I  require  you  most  especially  to 
pray  for  the  king's  most  excellent  Majesty, 
our  sovereign  Lord  James,  King  of  England, 
Scotland,  Prance,  and  Ireland,  defender  of 
the  faith,  and  supreme  governor  in  these  his 
realms,  and  all  other  his  dominions   and 
countries,  over  all  persons,  in  all  causes,  as 
well  ecclesiastical  as  temporal.     Ye  shall 
also  pray  for  our  gracious  Queen  Anne,  the 
noble  Prince  Henry,  and  the  rest  of  the  king 
and  queen's  royal  issue.     Ye  shall  also  pray 
for  the  ministers  of  God's  holy  word  and 
sacraments,  as  well  archbishops  and  bishops, 
as  other  pastors  and  curates.     Ye  shall  also 
pray  for  the  king's  most  honourable  council, 
and  for  all  the  nobility  and  magistrates  of 
this  realm,  that  all  and  every  of  these  in 
their  several  callings  may  serve  truly  and 
faithfully,  to  the  glory  of  God,  and  the  edi- 
fying and    well-governing  of   His    people, 
remembering  the  account  that  they  must 
make.     Also  ye  shall  pray  for  the  whole 
commons  of  this  realm,  that  they  may  live 
in  the  true  faith  and  fear  of  God,  in  humble 
obedience  to  the  king,  and  brotherly  charity 
one  to  another..    Finally,  let  us  praise  God 
for  all  those  which  are  departed  out  of  this 
life  in  the  faith  of  Christ,  and  pray  imto 
God  that  we  may  have  grace  to  direct  our 
lives  after  their  good  example,  that,  this  life 
ended,  we  may  be  made  partakers  with  them 
of  the  glorious  resurrection  in  the  life  ever- 
lasting,' always  concluding  with  the  Lord's 
Prayer." 

It  is  necessary  to  observe,  that  the  Church 
of  Scotland  alluded  to,  is  not  the  present 
Presbyterian  establishment.  (See  Presby- 
terian Establishment  in  Scotland.) 

BIDDLIANS.  Followers  of  John  Biddle 
the  Unitarian.  Biddle  was  educated  at 
Oxford,  and  was  afterwards  master  of  a  Free 
School  in  Gloucester  in  1641.  He  translated 
the  Kacovian  Catechism,  and  in  consequence 
of  his  writings,  in  which  be  denied  the 
divinity  of  our  Lord  and  of  the  Holy  Ghost, 
was  frequently  in  prison.  Yet  his  writings 
had-  great  influence,  so  much  so  that  it  was 
asserted  m  1665,  that  there  was  not  a  town 
or  village  in  England  where  there  were  not 
some  Unitarians. — Neale's  Hist,  of  the  Puri- 
tans, vol.  iv.  p.  157.     [H.] 

BIER.  (Sax.  hmr).  A  carriage  on  which 
the  dead  are  carried  to  the  grave.  It  is  to 
be  provided  by  the  parish. 

BIGAMY,  according  to  the  modern 
sense  of  the  word,  is  the  crime  of  having 
two  wives  at  once.  But  by  early  Church 
writers  it  seems  to  have  been  used  for  the 


BIEETTA 

marriage  of  a  second  wife  after  death  of  tbe 
first.     (See  Digamy.) 

BIRETTA.  A  square  cap  of  black  silk 
or  other  stuff,  in  form  of  a  flattened  pyramid ; 
worn  by  clergy  at  processions  and  other  out- 
door functions.  It  has  only  of  late  years 
been  used  at  all  in  England.  It  does  not 
seem  to  have  been  originally  an  exclusively 
ecclesiastical  headdress,  as  in  the  eleventh 
century  the  biretum  was  worn  as  a  badge  of 
honour  or  victory.     [H.] 

BIETH-DAYS.  In  the  ancient  Church 
this  term,  in  its  application  to  martyrs, 
and  the  festivals  in  honour  of  them,  ex- 
pressed the  day  on  which  they  suifered 
death,  or  were  born  into  the  glory  and 
happiness  of  the  kingdom  above.  In  this 
sense  it  stood  distinct  from  the  time  of  their 
natural  birth  into  the  world,  which  was 
considered  as  an  event  so  inferior,  that  its 
ordinary  designation  was  merged  in  that  of 
a  translation  to  the  joys  of  a  better  world. 
"When  ye  hear  of  a  birthday  of  saints, 
brethren,"  says  Peter  Chrysologus,  bishop  of 
Bavenna  in  the  fifth  century,  "  do  not  think 
that  that  is  spoken  of  in  which  they  are 
bom  on  earth,  of  the  flesh,  but  that  in 
which  they  are  born  from  earth  into  heaven, 
from  labour  to  rest,  from  temptations  to 
repose,  from  torments  to  delights,  not  fluctu- 
ating, but  strong,  and  stable,  and  eternal : 
from  the  derision  of  the  world  to  a  crown 
and  glory.  Such  are  the  birth-days  of  the 
martyrs  that  we  celebrate." 

BISHOP.  (See  Orders,  Apostolical  Suc- 
cession, Archhishop.)  This  is  the  title  now 
•given  to  those  who  are  of  the  highest  order 
in  the  Christian  ministry.  The  English 
word  comes  from  the  Saxon  hiscJwp,  which 
is  a  derivative  from  the  Greek  'Ettutkottos,  an 
overseer  or  inspector.  I.  The  office  in  the 
Apostolic  times.  II.  The  office  in  the 
Early  Christian  Church.  III.  The  office 
in  the  Church  of  England. 

I.  The  doctrine  of  Scripture,  as  it  relates 
to  the  office  of  bishop,  may  be  briefly  stated 
thus : — As  the  Lord  Jesus  Christ  was  sent 
by  the  Father,  so  were  the  apostles  sent 
by  him.  "As  my  Father  hath  sent  me," 
he  says  soon  after  his  resurrection,  "  even  so 
send  I  you-"  Now,  Jiow  had  the  Father 
sent  him?  He  had  sent  him  to  act  as  his 
supreme  minister  on  earth ;  as  such  to  ap- 
point under  him  subordinate  ministers,  and, 
to  do  what  he  then^  did  when  his  work  on 
earth  was  done,  to  hand  on  his  commission 
■to  others.  The  apostles,  in  like  manner, 
were  sent  by  Christ  to  act  as  his  chief 
ministers  in  the  Church,  to  appoint  subordi- 
nate ministers  under  them,  and  then,  as  he 
had  done,  to  hand  on  their  commission  to 
others.  And  on  this  commission,  after  our 
Lord  had  ascended  up  on  high,  the  apostles 
proceeded  to  act.     They  formed  their  con- 


BISHOP 


101 


verts  into  Churches  :  these  Churches  con- 
sisted of  baptized  believers,  to  officiate 
among  whom  subordinate  ministers,  priests, 
and  deacons  were  ordained;  while  the 
apostle  who  formed  any  particular  Church 
exercised  over  it  episcopal  superintendence, 
either  holding  an  occasional  visitation,  by 
sending  for  the  clergy  to  meet  him,  (as  St. 
Paul  summoned  to  Miletus  the  clergy  of 
Ephesus,)  or  else  transmitting  to  them  those 
pastoral  addresses,  which,  under  the  name 
of  Epistles,  form  so  important  a  portion  of 
Holy  Scripture.  At  length,  however,  it 
bscame  necessary  for  the  apostles  to  proceed 
yet  further,  and  to  do  as  their  Lord  had 
empowered  them  to  do,  to  hand  on  their 
commission  to  others,  that  at  their  own 
death  the  governors  of  the  Church  might 
not  be  extinct.  Of  this  we  have  an  instance 
in  Titus,  who  was  placed  in  Crete  by  St. 
Paul,  to  act  as  chief  pastor  or  bishop ;  and 
another  in  Timothy,  who  was  in  like  manner 
set  over  the  Church  of  Ephesus.  And 
when  Timothy  was  thus  appointed  to  the 
office  of  chief  pastor,  he  was  associated  with 
St.  Paul,  who,  in  writing  to  the  Philippians, 
commences  his  salutation  thus :  "  Paul 
and  Timotheus  to  the  servants  of  Jesus 
Christ  who  are  at  PhiHppi,  with  the 
bishops  and  deacons."  Now  we  have  here 
the  three  orders  of  the  ministry  clearly 
alluded  to.  The  title  of  bishop  is,  doubtless, 
given  to  the  second  order :  but  it  is  not  for 
words,  but  for  things,  that  we  are  to  con- 
tend. Titles  may  be  changed,  while  offices 
remain ;  so  senators  exist,  though  they  are 
not  now  of  necessity  old  men ;  and  most 
absurd  would  it  be  to  contend  that,  when 
we  speak  of  the  emperor  Constantine,  we 
can  mean  that  Constantine  held  no  other 
office  than  that  held  under  the  Roman  re- 
public, because  we  find  Cicero  also  saluted  as 
emperor.  So  stood  the  matter  in  the  first  age 
of  the  gospel,  when  the  chief  pastors  of  the 
Church  were  generally  designated  apostles  or 
angels,  i.e.  messengers  sent  by  God  himself. 
II.  In  the  next  century,  the  office  re- 
maining, the  designation  of  those  who  held 
it  was  changed,  the  title  of  Apostle  was 
confined  to  the  Twelve,  including  St.  Paul ; 
and  the  chief  pastors  who  succeeded  them 
were  thenceforth  called  bishops,  the  subordi- 
nate ministers  being  styled  priests  and 
deacons.  For  when  the  name  of  bishop  was 
given  to  those  ,who  had  that  oversight  of 
presbyters,  which  presbyters  had  of  their 
flocks,  it  would  have  been  manifestly  incon- 
venient, and  calculated  to  engender  confusion, 
to  continue  the  episcopal  name  to  the  second 
order.  And  thus  we  see,  as  Christ  was 
sent  by  the  Father,  so  he  sent  the  apostles ; 
as  the  apostles  were  sent  by  Chi-ist,  so  did 
they  send  the  first  race  of  bishops ;  as  the 
first  race  of  bishops  was  sent  by  the  apostles 


102 


BISHOP 


so  they  sent  the  second  race  of  bishops,  the 
second  the  third,  and  so  down  to  our  present 
bishops,  who  thus  trace  their  spiritual  de- 
scent from  St.  Peter  and  St.  Paul,  and  prove 
their  divine  authority  to  govern  the  Churches 
over  which  they  are  canonically  appointed 
to  preside. 

They  were  frequently  designated  the 
successors  of  the  apostles.  IrenjBus  speaks 
of  them  as  those  "  to  whom  the  apostles  de- 
livered the  Churches "  (adv.  Hsures.  v.  20). 
And  they  were  evidently  the  first  order, 
taking  the  position  of  the  apostles,  in  the 
several  Churches.  "  Unitatem,"  St.  Cyprian 
says,  "per  apostolos  nobis  successorihus 
traditam,  obtinere  curemus  "  (Ep.  ad  Cornel. 
45).  In  the  same  way  St.  Jerome,  in 
several  passages,  speaks  of  the  successors  of 
the  apostles.  "  Nunc  autem,"  he  writes  on 
Ps.  xlv.,  "quia  illi  (apostoli)  recesserunt  a 
mundo,  habes  pro  his  apostolos."  (See  also 
Up.  ad  Marcdlam  54 ;  ad  Evangelum,  46,  &c. ) 
The  bishops  at  the  council  of  Carthage  spoke 
of  the  "  Apostolos  .  .  .  quibus  hos  successi- 
mus."  So  St.  Augustine  in  his  sermon  on  the 
45th  Psalm,  says,  "  pro  Apostolis  .  .  .  consti- 
tuti  sunt  episcopi."  A  bishop's  see,  there- 
fore, was  called  "  sedes  apostolica."  St.  Au- 
gustine says,  "Christiana  societas  per  sedes 
Apostolorum,  et  successiones  episcoporum, 
certa  per  orbem  propagatione  diffunditur." 
Bishops  were  also  called  "princes  of  the 
people,"  or  by  the  Greek  writers  "  apxovres 
(<iOi.Ti<riS)v."  (Jerome  in  Ps.  xlv.  &c. ; 
Euseb.  vi.  c.  28 ;  Grigen.  Horn.  xi.  iji  Jerem., 
&c.)  The  word  "  papa  "  or  "  pope  "  is  also 
given  to  bishops  generally,  and  was  not  con- 
fined to  one  see,  or  arrogated  to  himself  by 
one  bishop,  as  was  afterwards  the  case.  (See 
Tertull.  de  Pudic,  c.  13 :  and  many  others 
as  Dionysius,  Jerome,  and  even  Arius,  who 
addressed  Alexander  as  "papa,"  Ep.  ad 
Euseb.  Nicom.  ap.  Tlieod.  lib.  i.  c.  5.)  St. 
Jerome,  writing  to  St.  Augustine,  addressed 
the  bishop  "  beatissimo  Papaj  Augustino  " 
{Ep.  Ixi.  ad  Pammach.') ;  and  epistles 
written  to  St.  Cyprian  are  addressed  "  Cy- 
priano  papaj "  (Ep.  xxx.-xxxi.  &c.)  It  was 
often  held,  after  the  apostolic  age,  tha,t 
bishops  and  presbyters  were  of  the  same 
order.  Such  an  opinion  Aerius  held;  but 
it  is  explained  by  the  fact  that  he  was  dis- 
appointed in  not  obtaining  a  bishopric.  (See 
Aerius.)  Some  of  the  schoolmen  use  the 
word  "order"  in  a  different  sense  to  the 
ancient  writers,  and  assert  that  bishops  and 
presbyters  do  not  differ  in  order,  but  in 
jurisdiction.  St.  Jerome  is  quoted  as  being 
of  the  same  opinion ;  but  this  is  satisfactorily 
disproved  by  Bingham,  Hooker,  and  Morinus. 
• — Bingham,  bk.  ii.  c.  1,  sec.  1 ;  Morinus,  de 
sacris  Ordin.  Exerc.  iii.  c.  3 ;  Hooker,  bk. 
vii.  c.  6,  &c. ;  Blunt's  Parish  Priest; 
Murray,  p.  291. 


BISHOP 

IIL  The  Church  of  England  has  always 
maintained  the  distinction  between  bishops 
and  priests.  After  the  Eeformation,  indeed, 
there  was  an  endeavour  to  make  the  two 
orders  one :  but  it  was  repressed.  Bancroft 
and  others  powerfully  maintained  the  superi- 
ority of  bishops  "  jure  divino,"  which  right 
had  been,  and  afterward  was  again  com- 
pletely acknowledged  by  the  Church  of 
England.  (Hook's  Archbishops,  vol.  x. ; 
Jewell,  Apol.  p.  10,  and  elsewhere,  Ed.  Camb., 
1847.)  The  episcopate  and  the  priesthood 
possess,  indeed,  alike  the  power  of  the  keys, 
and  of  administering  God's  word  and  sacra- 
ments ;  but  the  episcopate  alone  possess  the 
power  of  ordaining,  and  of  confirmation,  and 
is  supreme  in  matters  of  government  and 
discipline. 

The  judgment  of  the  Church  of  England 
with  respect  to  the  primitive  existence  of 
the  episcopal  order  is  this :  "  It  is  evident 
unto  all  men  diligently  reading  Holy  Scrip- 
ture and  ancient  authors,  that  from  the 
apostles'  time  there  have  been  these  orders 
of  ministers  in  Christ's  Church, — bishops, 
priests,  and  deacons."- — Pre/ace  to  tlie  Ordi- 
nation Service. 

(For  a  somewhat  different  view  of  the 
origin  of  the  Episcopal  order  as  developed 
out  of  the  Presbytery,  see  a  Dissertation  on 
the  Divine  Ministry  by  Bishop  Lightfoot, 
in  his  Commentary  on  the  Epistle  to  the 
Philippians.  Another  theory  has  lately  been 
propounded  (Hatch's  Bampton  Lectures, 
1880),  which  appears  to  be  singularly  desti- 
tute of  any  sound  historical  foundation.) 

In  the  time  of  the  Saxons,  as  indeed  was 
generally  the  case  throughout  Europe,  all 
bishops  and  abbots  sat  in  state  councils,  by 
reason  of  their  oifice,  as  they  were  spiritual 
persons,  and  not  upon  account  of  any 
tenures ;  but  after  the  Conquest  the  abbots 
sat  there  by  virtue  of  their  tenures,  and  the 
bishops  in  a  double  capacity,  as  bishops  and 
likewise  as  barons  by  tenure.  When,  in  the 
eleventh  year  of  H  enry  II.,  Archbishop  Becket 
was  condemned  in  parliament,  there  was  a 
dispute  who  should  pronounce  the  sentence, 
whether  a  bishop,  or  a  temporal  lord:  those 
who  desired  that  a  bishop  should  do  it, 
alleged  that  they  were  ecclesiastical  persons, 
and  that  it  was  one  of  their  own  order  who 
was  condemned ;  but  the  bishops  replied, 
that  this  was  not  a  spiritual  but  a  secular 
judgment ;  and  that  they  did  not  sit  there 
merely  as  bishops,  but  as  barons ;  and  told 
the  House  of  Peers,  Nos  barones,  vos  barones, 
pares  hie  sumxis.  In  the  very  year  before, 
in  the  tenth  of  Henry  II.,  it  was  declared  by 
the  Constitution  of  Clarendon,  that  bishops, 
and  all  other  persons  who  hold  of  the  king 
in  capite,  have  their  possessions  of  him  sicut 
haroniam,  et  sicut  cieteri  barones,  debent 
interesse  judiciis  curiee  regis,  &c. ;  and  that 


BISHOP'S 

they  ought  to  sit  there  likewise  as  bishops ; 
that  is,  not  as  mere  spiritual  persons,  vested 
with  a  power  only  to  ordain  and  confirm,  &c., 
but  as  they  are  the  governors  of  the  Church. 

They  sit  as  "  the  lords  spiritual,"  and  in 
old  times  the  guardian  of  the  spiritualities 
during  a  vacancy  was  summoned  to  parlia- 
ment. For  that  and  other  reasons  Hallam 
thought  they  did  not  sit  as  barons,  and  cer- 
tainly all  that  have  been  created  since  the 
middle  ages  have  not.  (See  Guardian  of 
Spiritualities.')    [H.] 

BISHOP'S  BIBLE.    (See  Bible.) 

BISHOPS  BOOK.  {^etArticles,The  Ten.) 

BISHOPS,  ELECTION  OF.  When 
cities  were  at  first  converted  to  Christi- 
anity, the  bishops  were  elected  by  the 
clergy  and  people :  for  it  was  then  thought 
convenient  that  the  laity,  as  well  as  the 
clergy,  should  concur  in  the  election,  that 
he  who  was  to  have  the  inspection  of  them 
all  might  come  in  by  general  consent. 

But  as  the  number  of  Christians  in- 
creased, this  was  found  to  be  inconvenient ; 
for  tumults  were  raised,  and  sometimes 
murders  committed,  at  such  popular  elec- 
tions. To  prevent  such  disorders,  the 
emperors,  being  then  Christians,  reserved 
the  election  of  bishops  to  themselves ;  but 
the  bishop  of  Kome,  when  he  had  obtained 
supremacy  in  the  Western  Church,  was 
unwilling  that  the  bishops  should  have  any 
dependence  upon  princes;  and  therefore 
brought  it  about  that  the  canons  in  cathe- 
dral churches  should  have  the  election  of 
their  bishops,  which  elections  were  usually 
confirmed  at  Rome. 

But  princes  had  stUl  some  power  in  those 
elections ;  and  in  England  we  read,  that,  in 
the  Saxon  times,  all  ecclesiastical  dignities 
were  conferred  by  the  king  in  parliament. 

From  these  circumstances  arose  the  long 
controversy  about  the  right  of  investiture, 
a  point  conceded,  so  far  as  our  Church  is 
concerned,  by  Henry  I.,  who  only  reserved 
the  ceremony  of  homage  to  himself  from 
the  bishops  in  respect  of  temporalities, 
King  John  afterwards  granted  his  charter, 
by  common  consent  of  the  barons,  that  the 
bishops  should  be  eligible  by  the  chapter, 
though  the  right  of  the  Crown  in  former 
times  was  acknowledged.  This  was  after- 
wards confirmed  by  several  Acts  of  Parlia- 
ment. This  election  by  the  chapter  was  to 
be  a  free  election,  but  founded  upon  the 
king's  conge  d'elire:  it  was  afterwards  to 
have  the  royal  assent;  and  the  newly- 
elected  bishop  was  not  to  have  his  tem- 
poralities assigned  until  he  had  sworn 
allegiance  to  the  king ;  but  it  was  agreed, 
that  confirmation  and  consecration  should 
be  in  the  power  of  the  pope,  so  that  foreign 
potentate  gained  in  effect  the  disposal  of  all 
the  bishoprics  in  England. 


BISHOPS 


103 


But  the  pope  was  not  content  with  this 
power  of  confirmation  and  consecration ; 
he  would  oftentimes  collate  to  the  bishop- 
rics himself:  hence,  by  the  25  Edward 
III.  st.  6,  it  was  enacted  as  follows,  viz. : 
The  free  elections  of  archbishops,  bishops, 
and  all  other  dignities  and  benefices  elective 
in  England,  shall  hold  from  henceforth 
in  the  manner  as  they  were  granted  by 
the  king's  progenitors,  and  the  ancestors 
of  other  lords,  founders  of  the  said  dignities 
and  other  benefices.  And  in  case  that 
reservation,  collation,  or  provision  be  made 
by  the  court  of  Eome,  of  any  archbishopric, 
bishopric,  dignity,  or  other  benefice,  in  dis- 
turbance of  the  free  elections  aforesaid, 
the  king  shall  have  for  that  time  the  col- 
lations to  the  archbishoprics  and  other 
dignities  elective  which  be  of  his  advowry, 
such  as  his  progenitors  had  before  that  free 
election  was  granted ;  since  that  the  election 
was  first  granted  by  the  king's  progenitors 
upon  a  certain  form  and  condition,  as  to  de- 
mand licence  of  the  king  to  choose,  and  after 
the  election  to  have  his  royal  assent,  and 
not  in  other  manner ;  which  conditions  not 
kept,  the  thing  ought  by  reason  to  resort  to 
its  first  nature. 

Afterwards,  by  the  25  Henry  VIII.  c.  20, 
all  Papal  jurisdiction  whatsoever  in  this 
matter  was  entirely  taken  away  :  by  which 
it  is  enacted — That  no  person  shall  be 
presented  and  nominated  to  the  bishop  of 
Borne,  otherwise  called  the  pope,  or  to  the 
see  of  Eome,  for  the  ofiice  of  an  archbishop 
or  bishop  ;  but  the  same  shall  utterly  cease, 
and  be  no  longer  used  within  this  realm. 

And  it  is  enacted  (omitting  immaterial 
words)  that "  at  every  avoidance  of  a  bishop- 
ric the  king  may  grant  unto  the  dean  and 
chapter  of  the  cathedral  church  a  licence 
under  the  great  seal  as  of  old  time  to  proceed 
to  election  of  a  bishop,  with  a  letter  missive 
containing  the  name  of  the  person  whom 
they  shall  elect.  .  .  .  And  if  they  defer  or 
delay  the  elections  above  twelve  days  after 
such  letter  missives  dehvered  to  them, 
then  the  king  shall  nominate  and  present 
by  letters  patent  such  person  as  he  shall 
think  able  and  convenient."  .  .  .  And  if  the 
said  dean  and  chapter  shall  not  proceed  and 
signify  the  electioQ  within  twenty  days,  or 
if  the  archbishop  and  bishops  directed  to 
consecrate  the  person  presented  to  them  by 
the  king  shall  omit  to  do  so  for  twenty 
days,  they  shall  all  respectively  incur  the 
penalties  of  praBmunire  under  the  Acts  of 
25  Edward  IIL  and  16  Richard  II. ;  which 
are  forfeiture  of  lands  and  goods  and  im- 
prisonment for  life.  The  bishops  of  the 
new  sees  (where  there  is  no  chapter)  are 
appointed  by  letters  patent  as  there  is  no 
dean  and  chapter  to  elect  them. 

In  the  case  of  Bishop  Hampden  in  1848, 


101 


BISHOPS 


the  material  parts  of  the  law  were  stated  as 
follows  by  Erie,  J.,  on  an  application  for 
a  mandamus  to  the  Archbishop  trf  Canter- 
bury to  hear  objections  to  the,  confirmation 
of  the  bishop's  election,  on  which  the  judges 
of  the  Queen's  Bench  were  equally  divided, 
and  so  the  mandamus  was  refused,  and  the 
question  has  never  been  tried  again,  nor  is 
likely  to  be,  though  an  opposition  was  sub- 
sequently rejected  by  a  vicar-general  to 
Bishop  Temple's  confirmation  in  1829. 
(Stephens'  Laws  of  tlie  Clergy,  1397.)  He 
said,  "The  reference  to  history  leads  me 
to  the  conclusion  that  bishoprics  were 
donatives  imder  the  Saxon  and  Korman 
kings.  From  the  charter  of  King  John 
to  the  25th  of  Edw.  III.,  bishops  were 
elected  by  the  chapter  and  confirmed  by 
the  archbishop ;  and  from  Edw.  III.  to  the 
25th  of  Hen.  VHI.  c.  20,  the  pope  had 
superseded  the  archbishop,  except  on  a  few 
occasions  when  he  was  powerless.  The 
question  turns  on  the  effect  of  that  sta- 
tute which  was  varied  by  1  Edw.  VI.  c.  2, 
and  bishoprics  made  donatives  again ;  and 
that  was  repealed  by  Mary,  and  not  re- 
stored by  1  Eliz.  c.  1,  but  that  of  Hen.  VIII. 
was.  The  preamble  of  s.  3  recites  that 
the  manner  of  electing,  presenting,  and 
consecrating  bishops  had  not  been  plainly 
expressed  by  23  Hen.  VIII.  c.  20,  and  for 
remedy  thereof  enacts  that  the  chapter 
shall  elect  the  person  named  in  the  letters 
missive  of  the  king  within  twelve  days ; 
and  in  case  of  default  the  king  may  nominate 
and  present  to  the  archbishop  (by  letters 
patent)  such  person  as  he  thinks  able  and 
convenient,  and  by  s.  5  in  case  of  such 
nomination  the  archbishop  shall  with  all 
due  speed  invest  and  consecrate  him  ;  and 
in  case  the  chapter  shall  elect  the  person 
named  their  election  shall  stand  good,  and 
the  person  so  elected,  after  certification  to 
the  king,  shall  be  reported  and  taken  by  the 
name  of  lord  elected  of  the  bishopric.  Then 
the  oath  of  fealty  being  made  to  the  king 
he  shall  signify  the  said  election  to  the 
archbishop  commanding  him  to  confirm  the 
said  election  and  to  invest  and  consecrate 
the  person  so  elected.  And  by  s.  7  if  any 
archbishop  after  any  such  election  or  nomi- 
nation signified  do  not  confirm  and  consecrate 
the  person  so  elected  or  nominated  within 
twenty  days,  or  if  any  person  [i.e.  any 
archbishop's  vicar  general  for  instance]  shall 
admit  any  process  to  the  contrary  of  the  due 
execution  of  this  act  he  shall  incur  the 
penalties  of  a  prajmunire."  On  several  sub- 
sequent occasions  the  archbishop's  ofiScials 
have  accordingly  refused  to  hear  opponents 
to  the  confirmation  on  grounds  of  personal 
fitness.  It  might  be  different  if  an  objection 
was  made  to  the  regularity  of  the  election, 
as  e.g.  that  a  majority  of  the  chapter  had 


BISHOPS 

voted  a,gainst  it.  It  may  be  the  duty  of 
the  .official  in  that  case  to  report  that  the 
chapter  had  not  made  an  election,  and  leave 
the  Crown  to  deal  with  them. 

The  following  are  the  formalities  observed 
when  a  bishop  dies  or  is  traiuslated :  The 
dean  and  chapter  certify  the  Queen  thereof 
in  Chancery,  and  pray  leave  of  the  Queen 
to  make  election.  Thereupon  the  sovereign 
grants  a  licence  to  them  under  the  great 
seal,  to  elect  the  person  named  in  her  letters 
missive.  Within  twelve  days  after  the 
receipt  of  this  licence  they  are  to  proceed  to 
election.  And  the  dean  and  chapter  certify 
it  under  their  common  seal  to  the  Queen, 
and  to  the  archbishop  of  the  province,  and 
to  the  bishop  elected ;  then  the  Queen  gives 
her  royal  assent  under  the  great  seal, 
directed  to  the  archbishop,  commanding 
him  to  confirm  and  consecrate  the  .bishop 
thus  elected.  The  archbishop  subscribes  it 
thus,  •  viz.  Fiat  confirmatio,  and  grants  a 
commission  to  his  vicar-general  to  perform 
all  acts  requisite  to  that  purpose.  Upon 
this  the  vicar-general  issues  a  citation  to 
summon  all  persons  who  oppose  this  election, 
to  appear,  &c.,  which  citation  (in  the  pro- 
vince of  Canterbury)  is  affixed  by  an  officer 
of  the  Arches,  on  the  door  of  Bow  church, 
and  he  makes  proclamation  there  for  the 
opposers  to  appear. 

By  the  Act  of  Henry  VIII.  the  mandate 
for  confirmation  and  consecration  of  an 
archbishop  goes  to  the  other  archbishop 
with  some  other  bishops,  or  to  four  bishops 
only.  The  confirmations  of  the  northern 
bishops  usually  take  place  in  St.  James's 
church,  Piccadilly,  under  licence  from  the 
Archbishop  of  Canterbury,  by  the  Vicar- 
General  of  York.  The  present  Archbishop 
of  York  was  confirmed  there  by  Bishop 
Tait  of  London,  in  person,  and  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury  was  confirmed  by  four 
southern  bishops.  It  having  been  decided 
by  the  Dean  of  Arches  and  some  assessors 
in  the  case  of  Bishop  Lee,  and  by  the  Vicar- 
General  of  Canterbury,  and  by  the  Queen's 
Bench  as  above  m.entioned,  that  confirma- 
tion is  a  mere  form,  and  that  the  person  who 
is  ordered-  to  confirm  can  hear  no  objections 
to  the  bishop  elected,  it  may  be  thought 
strange  that  the  House  of  Commons  in  1881 
rejected  a  bill  for  abolishing  that  ceremony ; 
of  which  the  prominent  parts  are  these.  Im- 
mediately before  morning  prayer  or  the  Litany, 
the  proctor  for  the  electing  chapter  presents 
to  the  bishop  elect  in  the  vestry  a  certificate 
of  the  election  and  "  earnestly  prays  his 
lordship  to  consent  to  it."  He  then  signs  a 
"  schedule  of  consent,"  and  they  go  to  the 
service.  After  that  the  vicar-general,  in  his 
doctor's  robes  (if  he  is  one),  or  a  bishop  if 
confirming  an  archbishop  in  person,  takes 
his  seat  at  a  table  just  outside  the  com- 


BISHOPS 

munion  rails;  and  the  cathedral's  proctor 
IDi-esents  to  him  the  Queen's  ^letters  patent 
for  the  confirmation,  and  the  vicar  directs 
them  to  be  read  by  the  metropolitan  regis- 
trar, and  the  proctor  prays  him  to  decree 
that  it  be  proceeded  with.  The  vicar 
decrees  accordingly.  The  bishop  elect  then 
takes  his  seat  opposite  to  him,  and  the 
proctor  "judicially  produces  his  lordship 
and  exhibits  an  original  mandate"  and  a 
certificate  endorsed  thereon,  and  prays  that 
opposers  be  publicly  called :  vfhich  the 
vicar  orders  to  be  done,  and  it  is  done 
accordingly,  and  they  are  told  that  they 
shall  be  heard.  But  if  any  respond  to  that 
invitation  the  vicar  has  to  tell  them  they 
cannot  be  heard — except  perhaps  as  aforesaid. 
Then  the  proctor  "  accuses  of  contumacy  all 
and  singular  persons  who  have  been  cited 
and  publicly  called  and  have  not  appeared, 
and  prays  that  they  be  precluded  from 
further  opposing,  and  that  the  business  may 
proceed,"  and  says,  "  I  porrect  a  schedule 
and  pray  that  it  may  be  read,"  and  the 
vicar  does  read  and  signs  it. 

The  proctor  next  "in  pain  of  the  con- 
tmnacy  of  all  such  persons"  as  aforesaid, 
■"  gives  in  a  summary  petition  "  and  "  prays 
that  it  be  decreed  to  proceed  summarily 
and  plainly,  and  that  the  term  be  assigned  to 
prove  the  same " ;  and  the  vicar  decrees 
accordingly.  Then  "  in  supply  of  proof  of 
the  matters  contained  in  the  summary 
petition,"  the  proctor  exhibits  a  certificate 
of  the  election,  and  the  pubhc  instrument  of 
the  bishop's  consent  thereto,  and  "  prays 
that  a  time  may  be  assigned  for  him  to 
hear  sentence  instantly."  And  the  vicar 
does  so.  Then  the  proctor  prays  that 
opposers  may  be  called  again,  and  the  vicar 
says,  "  Call  them  again,"  and  they  are  called 
again,  and  again  accused  of  contumacy  for 
not  coming;  and  the  proctor  "porrects 
another  schedule,"  which  the  vicar  reads 
and'  signs.  The  proctor  then  informs  him 
that  the  bishop  is  ready  to  take  the  oath 
and  sign  the  declaration  required  by  law, 
and  he  does  so.  Then  the  proctor  prays  a 
definitive  sentence  in  writing,  and  the  vicar 
reads  and  signs  and  gives  it.  Then  the 
proctor,  for  himself  and  the  lord  bishop 
elected  and  confirnied,  prays  a  public  instru- 
ment and  letters  testimonial  touching  the 
premises ;  and  the  vicar  says, "  We  do  decree 
as  prayed";  and  so  ends  this  remarkable 
ceremony,  of  which  it  would  be  a  pity  if  no 
.  record  survived  in  case  it  should  ever  be 
abolished.  The  form  does  not  appear  to 
have  had  any  real  authority,  but  was 
voluntarily  revived  when  confirmation  was 
re-enacted.  The  bishops  of  the  new  sees 
without  chapters  are  presented  for  consecra- 
tion simply  by  letters  patent,  according  to 
the  Acts'  for  them,  until  they  shall  have 


BLASPHEMY 


105 


chapters.  It  is  hardly  credible  that  some 
persons  Jiave  seriously  urged  the  necessity 
for  chapters  in  the  new  sees  in  order  that 
their  bishops  may  be  elected  and  confirmed. 
Confirmation  takes  place  on  translation  to 
another  see,  after  election,  and  completes  it, 
except  that  the  bishop  has  still  to  "do 
homage  to  the  Queen  for  his  temporalities," 
which  include  all  his  patronage.  The  pre- 
amble of  2  Eliz.  c.  4,  which  abolished 
election  of  the  Irish  bishops,  contains  this 
very  true  recital :  "  Forasmuch  as  the  elec- 
tions of  bishops  in  Ireland  "  (and  why  there 
only  ?)  "  be  as  well  to  the  long  delay  as  to 
the  costs  and  charges  of  such  persons,  and 
such  elections  be  in  very  deed  no  elections, 
but  .  .  .  shadows  and  pretences,  saving  to 
no  purpose ; "  and  thereupon  made  them 
donative.  The  bishop  of  Gloucester  and 
Bristol,  by  6  &  7  W.  IV.  c.  77,  is  elected 
by  the  two  chapters  alternately.  Bath 
and  Wells  has  no  chapter  at  Bath,  any 
more  than  Lichfield  and  Coventry  (as  Lich- 
field was  called  until  the  same  Act)  had  at 
Coventry.     [G.] 

BLASPHEMY.  (From  the  Greek  word, 
/3Xacr0i;/ie'<B,  quasi  ^Xdima  rrjv  <f)^;xi;i'.)  An 
injury  to  the  reputation  of  any,  but  now 
used  almost  exclusively  to  designate  that 
which  derogates  from  the  honour  of  God, 
whether  by  detracting  from  his  person  or 
attributes,  or  by  attributing  to  the  crea- 
ture what  is  due  to  God  alone. 

Blasphemy  is  a  crime  both  in  the  civil 
and  canon  law,  and  is  punishable  both  by 
the  statute  and  common  daw  of  England. 

The  sin  of  blasphemy  incurred  the  pub- 
lic censure  of  the  primitive  Christian 
Church.  They  distinguished  blasphemy 
into  three  sorts.  1.  The  blasphemy  of 
apostates,  whom  the  heathen  persecutors 
obliged,  not  only  to  deny,  but  to  curse 
Christ.  Pliny  in  a  letter  to  Trajan  gives  an 
account  of  some  apostates  who  worshipped 
the  images  of  the  emperor,  and  of  the  gods, 
and  cursed  Jesus  Christ.  (Plin.  Ep.  97, 
lib.  X.) 

2.  The  blasphemy  of  heretics,  and  others, 
who  though  Christians,  yet  by  impious 
doctrine  or  profane  discourses,  derogated 
from  the  majesty  and  honour  of  God  and 
His  holy  religion. 

3.  The  third  sort  of  blasphemy  was  that 
against  the  Holy  Ghost:  concerning  which 
the  opinions  of  the  ancients  varied.  Some 
applied  it  to  the  sin  of  lapsing  into  idolatry 
and  apostasy,  and  denying  Christ  in  time  of 
persecution.  Others  made  it  to  consist  in 
denying  Christ  to  be  God;  in  which  sense 
Hilary  charges  the  Arians  with  sinning 
against  the  Holy  Ghost.  Origen  thought 
that  whoever,  after  having  received  the 
gifts  of  the  Holy  Ghost  by  baptism,  after- 
wards ran  into  sin,  was  guilty  of  the  un- 


106 


BLASPHEMY 


pardonable  sin  against  the  Holy  Ghost. 
Athanasius  refutes  this  notion,  and  delivers 
his  own  opinion  in  the  following  manner. 
"  The  Pharisees,  in  our  Saviour's  time,  and 
the  Arians,  in  our  own,  running  into  the 
same  madness,  denied  the  real  Word  to  be 
incarnate,  and  ascribed  the  works  of  the 
Godhead  to  tlie  devU  and  his  angels. — They 
put  the  devil  in  the  place  of  God — which 
was  the  same  thing  as  if  they  had  said, 
that  the  world  was  made  by  Beelzebub, 
that  the  sun  rose  at  his  command,  and  the 
stars  m.oved  by  his  direction. — For  this 
reason  Christ  declared  their  sin  impardon- 
able,  and  their  punishment  inevitable  and 
eternal."  St.  Ambrose  likewise  defined 
this  sin  to  be  a  denying  the  Divipity  of 
Christ.  There  are  others,  who  make  it  to 
consist  in  denying  the  Divinity  of  the  Holy 
Ghost.  Epiphanius  calls  these  blasphemers 
wev/iaToiMixot,  "fighters  against  the  Holy 
Ghost."  Others,  again,  place  this  sin  in 
a  perverse  and  malicious  ascribing  the 
operations  of  the  Holy  Spirit  to  the  power 
of  the  devil ;  and  that  against  express 
knowledge  and  conviction  of  conscience. 

St.  Augustine  speaks  often  of  this  crime, 
and  places  it  in  a  continued  resistance  of 
the  motions  and  graces  of  the  Holy  Spirit, 
and  persisting  in  impenitency  to  our  death. 
"  Impenitency  is  the  blasphemy,  which  has 
neither  remission  in  this  world,  nor  in  the 
world  to  come ;  but  of  this  no  one  can  judge 
so  long  as  a  man  continues  in  this  life." 

Bacchiarius,  a  contemporary  of  St.  Au- 
gustine, adds  that  it  is  such  a  despair  of 
God's  mercy,  that  men  give  up  all  hopes, 
and  go  on  sinning  without  repentance. 

The  schoolmen,  from  the  writings  of  the 
ancients,  "according  to  their  usual  chem- 
istry, have  extracted  five  several  species  of 
blasphemy  against  the  Holy  Ghost ;  viz. 
despair,  presumption,  final  impenitency, 
obstinacy  in  sin,  and  opposition  to  the 
known  truth. — Cypr.  Ep.  10;  Hilar,  in 
Mat.  can.  xxxi.  p.  184;  Athan.  m  illitd, 
Quicunque  dixerit  verbum,  &c.,  tom.  i.  p.  971; 
Ambros.  Comment,  in  Luc.  lib.  vii.  c.  12 ; 
Epiphan.  Hssres.  Ixxiv. ;  Aug.  Serm.  xi. ; 
de  Verbis  Dom,ini,  c.  iii. ;  de  Vera  et  Falsa 
Pxn.  cap.  iv.,  and  elsewhere;  Bacchiar. 
Epist.  de  recipiend.  lapsis ;  Bib.  Patr. 
turn.  iii.  p.  133;  Bingham,  bk.  xvi. 
c.  vii.    [H.] 

BLASPHEMY  OE  BLASPHEMOUS 
LIBEL.  It  has  been  decided  in  every 
case  which  has  been  tried  in  modem  times, 
that  the  publication  of  "coarse  and  brutal" 
reflections  either  on  our  Lord  personally  or 
on  either  the  New  or  the  Old  Testament,  or 
Christianity  in  general,  are  still  blasphemous 
libels  at  common  law,  which  has  not  been 
altered  by  what  are  popularly  called  the 
Toleration   Acts ;    but   no   one    has    long 


BLOOD 

been  or  is  even  likely  to  be  convicted  for 
publishing  fair  arguments  on  the  subject. 
It  is  for  the  ecclesiastical  courts  in  the 
case  of  clergymen  to  decide  whether  any 
particular  publication  about  religion  over- 
steps the  limits  of  fair  argument ;  and  so 
clergymen  have  been  deprived  for  dogmati- 
cally denouncing  whole  books  of  the  Bible 
or  any  clear  doctrine  of  the  Church.  That 
was  Mr.  Voysey's  offence  as  a  clergyman 
bound  to  teach  nothing  contrary  thereto, 
or  else  to  leave  his  position.  Several  other 
clergymen  of  very  different  opinions  es- 
caped, being  thought  only  to  have  argued 
fairly  for  what  was  held  not  to  be  expressly 
prohibited  by  the  Church. 

This  is  quite  in  accordance  with  the  law 
about  seditious  libels,  which  may  be  called 
blasphemy  against  the  state.  Everybody 
knows  that  it  is  lawful  to  advocate  any 
reform  of  the  law  by  fair  and  reasonable 
discussion ;  and  everybody  knows  that  there 
is  and  ought  to  be  a  limit  beyond  which 
the  language  used  for  that  purpose  becomes 
seditious ;  and  that  has  to  be  determined 
in  every  case  by  the  judge  and  jury  for 
themselves.  Even  in  common  libel  cases 
a  cautious  and  able  writer  might  do  an 
opponent  a  great  deal  more  harm  with  im- 
punity as  to  any  risk  of  damages  than  an 
incautious  or  stupid  one  might  do  by  coarse 
personal  abuse,  for  which  a  British  jury 
would  be  sure  to  give  large  damages.  We 
are  therefore  quite  unable  to  understand 
how  an  able  legal  writer  can  have  per- 
suaded himself  that  the  law  of  blasphemous 
libel  ought  to  be  abolished,  in  order  that 
the  great  majority  of  the  people  of  Eng- 
land may  be  far  more  offended  than  by 
the  grossest  seditious  or  personal  libel,  all 
for  the  sake  of  some  theoretical  or  abstract 
legal  logic;  which  would  do  nobody  any 
good  except  those  few  persons  who  are 
every  now  and  then  convicted  and  richly 
deserve  worse  punishment  than  they  get,  or 
ever  will  get  through  a  judge  and  jury.  [G.] 

BLACK  LETTER  DAYS.  The  minor 
festivals  are  so  called  because  in  the 
calendar  their  names  are  printed  in  black, 
while  those  of  the  greater  festivals  are 
printed  in  red  letters. 

BLACK  EUBHIC.  A  name  sometimes 
given  to  the  "  declaration  on  kneeling  "  at  the 
end  of  the  communion  ofiice.  It  was  pro- 
bably drawn  up  by  Cranmer,  and  was 
signed  by  the  king,  but  was  not  added  to 
the  Prayer  Book  till  the  last  revision  in 
1661.  One  important  alteration  was  made 
on  the  original  declaration ;  the  words 
corporal  presence  being  substituted  for 
"  real  and  essential  presence." 

BOOKS  OF  HOURS.     (See  Prymers.) 

BLOOD.  Prom  the  earliest  times  the 
clergy  have  been  forbidden  to  sit  in  judg- 


BODY 

ment  on  capital  oflfences,  or  in  cases  of 
blood ;  a  rule  still  maintained  among  us ; 
for  the  bishops,  who,  as  peers  of  parlia- 
ment, are  a  component  part  of  the  highest 
court  of  judicature  in  the  kingdom,  al- 
ways retire  when  such  cases  are  before  the 
House. 

BODY.  The  Church  is  called  a  body. 
(Rom.  xii.  5 ;  ]  Cor.  x.  17 ;  xii.  13 ;  Eph. 
iv.  4 ;  Col.  iii.  15.)  Like  every  other  body, 
society,  or  corporation,  it  has  a  prescribed 
form  of  admission,  baptism;  a  constant 
badge  of  membership,  the  Eucharist ;  pecu- 
liar duties,  repentance,  faith,  obedience ; 
peculiar  privileges,  forgiveness  of  sins,  pre- 
sent grace,  and  future  glory ;  regularly 
constituted  officers,  bishops,  priests,  and 
deacons.  The  Church  is  the  body,  of 
which  Christ  is  the  Head. 

BOHEMIAN  BRETHREN.  A  sect 
which  sprung  up  in  Bohemia  early  in  the 
sixteenth  century.  In  1503  they  were  ac- 
cused by  the  Roman  Catholics  to  King 
Ladislaus  II.,  who  published  an  edict 
against  them,  forbidding  them  to  hold  any 
meetings,  either  privately  or  publicly. 
When  Luther  declared  himself  against  the 
Church  of  Rome,  the  Bohemian  Brethren 
endeavoured  to  join  his  party.  At  first,  that 
reformer  showed  a  great  aversion  to  them 
as  they  denied  the  presence  of  Christ  in  the 
Lord's  supper,  but  the  Bohemians  sending 
their  deputies  to  him  in  1535,  with  a  full 
account  of  their  doctrines  which  they 
modified,  he  acknowledged  that  they  were  a 
society  of  Christians  whose  doctrine  came 
near  to  the  purity  of  the  gospel.  This  sect 
published  a  confession  of  faith  in  1532, 
which  was  formally  presented  to  Ferdinand, 
king  of  Hungary  and  Bohemia,  in  1535,  in 
which  they  renounced  Anabaptism,  which 
they  at  first  professed ;  upon  this  an  union 
was  concluded  with  the  Lutherans.  But 
after  the  death  of  Luther  they  united  them- 
selves with  the  Swiss,  or  Zuinghans,  whose 
opinions  from  thenceforth  they  continued  to 
foUow. — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  iii.  27; 
Du  Pin,  vol.  xii.  bk.  ii.  c.  30;  Blunt's 
Dictionary  of  Sects,  pp.  45,  74. 

BOUNTY,     QUEEN     ANNE'S     (See 

BOUNDS,  BEATING  OP  THE.  This 
was  an  old  custom,  which  is  still  kept  up  in 
a  few  parishes.  The  minister,  accompanied 
by  his  churchwardens  and  parishioners,  used 
on  one  of  the  rogation  days,  to  go  round  the 
bounds  of  the  parish,  pray  to  God  for  a 
blessing  on  the  fruits  of  the  earth,  and  to 
preserve  the  rights  and  properties  of  their 
parish.  It  is  supposed  that  this  custom 
had  its  origin  in  the  heathen  feast  of  "  Ter- 
minalia" ;  but  however  this  may  be,  it  was 
invested  in  Christian  times  with  considerable 
religious  observance.   It  is  referred  to  in  the 


BOWING 


107 


"  Canons  of  Cuthbert,"  Archbishop  of  Can- 
terbury A.D.  747,  and  rogation  days  are 
called  "  gang  dagas,"  or  days  of  peram- 
bulation, in  the  laws  of  Alfred. 

In  the  Injunctions  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  it 
is  ordered  that  "  the  curate  shall,  at  certain 
and  convenient  places,  admonish  the  people 
to  give  thanks  unto  God,  for  His  benefits 
.  .  .  .  and  shall  inculcate  such  sentences  as 
'  cursed  be  he  which  translateth  the  bounds 
and  doles  of  his  neighbour.' " 

In  the  Homilies  an  especial  exhortation 
is  given  "  to  be  spoken  to  such  parishes, 
when  they  use  their  perambulation  in 
Rogation  Week." — Brand's  Antiq.  p.  265 : 
Horn,  ad  loc.    [H.] 

BOWING.  I.  At  the  name  of  Jesus, 
This  ancient  custom  is  founded  on  that 
Scripture,  where  it  is  declared,  that  "  God 
hath  given  Him  a  Name  which  is  above 
every  Name ;  that  at  the  Name  of  Jesus 
every  knee  should  bow,  and  every  tongue 
should  confess  that  Jesus  Christ  is  Lord,  to 
the  glory  of  God  the  Father"  (Phil.  ii.  9), 
&c.  The  bowing  at  the  name  of  our  Lord 
has  always  been  especially  observed  in  re- 
citing the  Creed,  when,  also,  it  has  been  the 
custom  to  turn  to  the  east.     (See  East.) 

In  the  Injunctions  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  of 
1559,  it  was  ordered  "  That  whensoever  the 
Name  of  Jesus  shall  be  in  any  lesson, 
sermon,  or  otherwise  in  the  church  pro- 
nounced, due  reverence  be  made,  with  low- 
ness  of  courtesy,"  &c.  In  the  18th  canon 
of  1604,  it  is  ordered  that  "  When  in  time 
of  Divine  service  the  Lord  Jesus  shall  be 
mentioned,  due  and  lowly  reverence  shall 
be  done  by  all  persons  present,  as  it  hath 
been  accustomed ;  testifying  by  these  out- 
ward ceremonies  and  gestures,  their  inward 
humility.  Christian  resolution,  and  due  ac- 
knowledgment that  the  Lord  Jesus  Christ, 
the  true  eternal  Son  of  God,  is  the  only 
Saviour  of  the  world,"  &c.  (See  also  Hooker, 
Ecc.  Pol.  bk.  v.  c.  XXX.  3.) 

II.  At  entering  or  leaving  church.  This 
was  an  ancient  custom ;  but  there  is  no 
distinct  rule  found  in  the  ancient  Fathers 
or  councils  on  this  point.  (Bingham,  Ant. 
bk.  viii.  c.  x.  7).  This  reverent  custom  is 
still  practised  at  Windsor  Chapel,  in  college 
chapels  and  cathedrals,  and  has  been  re- 
tained or  revived  in  many  churches.  In 
the  Canons  of  1640,  agreed  upon  by  the 
synods  of  London  and  York,  it  is  said,  "  We 
heartily  commend  it  to  all  good  and  well- 
affected  people,  that  they  be  ready  to 
tender  to  the  Lord  their  reverence  and 
obeisance,  both  at  their  coming  in  and 
going  out  of  church,  according  to  the  most 
ancient  custom  of  the  primitive  Church  in 
the  purest  times." — Sparrow's  Coll.  p.  263. 

III.  To  the  altar.  This  may  be  included 
under  the  latter  head,  the  Church  of  England 


108 


BOYLE'S 


having  discarded  the  mediajval  idea  of  ador- 
ing the  elements,  while  at  "the  same  time 
she  has  not  discarded  the  reverence  to  be 
shown  in  the  sanctuary. 

As  the  Jews  worshipped,  "  lifting  up 
their  hands  towards  the  mercy-seat  (Psal. 
xxviii.  2),  and  even  the  cherubim  were 
formed  with  their  faces  looking  towards  it 
(Exod.  XXV.  19),  so  the  primitive  Chris- 
tians did  in  their  worship  look  towards  the 
altar,  of  which  the  mercy-seat  was  a  type. 

But  reverence  is  paid  not  to  the  altar,  but 
to  Him  that  sanctifies  the  altar.  "  Shall_  I 
how,"  says  Archbishop  Laud,  "  to  men  in 
each  House  of  Parliament,  and  shall  I  not 
bow  to  God  in  His  house  ?  Surely  I  must 
worship  God,  and  bow  to  Him,  though 
neither  altar  or  communion  table  be  in  the 
church." — Hook's  Archbishops,  vol.  xi.  p. 
196 ;  Laud's  Works  (Parker),  vol.  iv.  285. 

IV.  At  different  parts  of  the  service.  At 
the  Gloria  Patri,  and  whenever  the  Holy 
Trinity  is  mentioned  or  referred  to ;  when, 
.also,  there  is  reference  to  our  Lord's  Incar- 
nation, as  at  the  words  "and  was  made 
man  " ;  it  is  customary  in  some  churches  to 
bow.  With  regard  to  this,  the  "  note  "  in 
the  first  book  of  Edw.  VI.  gives  advice ; 
"  these  customs  may  be  used  or  left,  as 
«very  man's  devotion  serveth,  without 
.blame." 

So  also  in  the  Canons  of  1640  above 
referred  to,  with  regard  to  bowing,  these 
words  occur :  "  In  the  practice  or  omission  of 
this  rite,  we  desire  that  the  rule  of  charity 
prescribed  by  the  apostle  may  be  observed, 
which  is,  that  they  which  use  this  rite 
despise  not  those  who  use  it  not,  and  they 
who  use  it  not,  condemn  not  them  who  use 
it."   [H.] 

BOYLE'S  LECTURE.  A  lecture  founded 
under  the  will  of  the  Hon.  Robert  Boyle,  in 
1661,  which  consists  of  a  course  of  eight 
sermons,  to  prove  the  truth  of  Christianity 
against  infidels,  and  to  answer  new  difficul- 
ties, &c.,  without  entering  into  controversies 
existing  among  Christians.  The  lectures 
■are  delivered  in  the  Chapel  Koyal  at  White- 
hall on  some  of  the  Sundays  after  Easter  in 
the  afternoon. 

BRANDENBURG,  CONFESSION  OP. 
A  formulary,  or  confession  of  faith,  drav?n 
up  in  the  city  of  Brandenburg,  in  1614,  by 
order  of  the  elector,  John  Sigismund,  with 
a  view  to  reconcile  the  tenets  of  Luther 
■with  those  of  Calvin,  and  to  put  an  end  to 
the  disputes  occasioned  by  the  Confession 
of  Augsburg. — Soames'  Mosheim,  iv.  156. 

BRASSES.  Monumental  slabs  of  brass, 
much  used  in  the  middle  ages,  with  effigies 
carved  in  outline  upon  them.  An  historical 
and  descriptive  account  of  brasses  iised  as 
sepulchral  memorials  would  occupy  too 
much    space   for   this   work.     Perhaps   as 


BRASSES 

mutth  of  the  history  as  we  shall  be  ex- 
pected to  give  is  included  in  the  following 
paragraph  from  the  "  Manual  of  Monu- 
mental Brasses,"  (Oxford,  1848,)  to  which 
we  may  refer  for  a  full  discussion  on  this 
subject. 

"  The  earliest  brass  of  which  we  have 
any  record  was  that  of  Simon  de  Beau- 
champ,  who  died  before  1208,  thus  men- 
tioned by  Leland,  '  He  lyith  afore  the 
highe  altare  of  S.  Paule's  chirch  in  Bede- 
ford,  with  this  epitaphie  graven  in  bras, 
and  set  on  a  flat  marble  stone : — 

De  Bello  Campo  jacet  hie  sub  marmore  Simon 
Fundator  de  Neweham.' 

Several  others  of  the  thirteenth  century, 
now  lost,  are 'enumerated  by  Gough. 

At  the  present  time,  the  earliest  brass 
known  is  that  of  Sir  John  d'Abernon, 
1277,  at  Stoke  d'Abernon  in  Surrey ;  one 
other  of  the  same  century  still  remains  at 
Trumpington.  From  this  period  their  num- 
bers gradually  increased  until  about  the 
middle  of  the  sixteenth  century,  when  they 
became  less  common.  The  latest  observed 
example  is  at  St.  Mary  Cray,  Kent,  1776. 
It  is  remarkable  that  the  earliest  brasses  are 
quite  equal,  in  beauty  of  form  and  execution, 
to  any  of  a  later  date.  From  the  early  part 
of  the  fifteenth  century  a  gradual  decline  of 
the  art  is  visible,  and  towards  the  end  of 
the  sixteenth  century  it  became  utterly  de- 
generate. 

It  seems  needless  to  add,  that  the  interest 
of  brasses  is  derived,  in  a  great  degree, 
from  the  light  which  they  throw  on  me- 
diEBval  costume,  and  the  habits  of  our  an- 
cestors. The  destruction  of  bi-asses  at  the 
Reformation  was  great;  at  the  Rebellion 
still  greater.  The  mention  of  this  spolia- 
tion by  Drake,  the  historian  of  York,  is 
worth  volumes  of  mere  particulars.  "  Let 
no  man  hereafter  say,  '  Exegi  monumentum 
eere  perennius ; '  for  now  an  asris  sacra, 
fames  has  robbed  us  of  most  of  the  ancient 
monumental  inscriptions  that  were  in  the 
church.  At  the  Reformation  this  hair- 
brained  zeal  began  to  show  itself  against 
painted  glass,  stone  statues^  and  grave- 
stones, many  of  which  were  defaced  and 
utterly  destroyed,  along  with  other  more 
valuable  monuments  of  the  Church,  till 
Queen  Elizabeth  put  a  stop  to  these  most 
scandalous  doings  by  an  express  Act  of  Par- 
liament. In  our  late  civil  wars,  and  during 
the  usurpation,  our  zealots  began  again 
these  depredations  on  grave-stones,  and 
stripped  and  pillaged  to  the  minutest  piece 
of  metal.  I  know  it  is  urged  that  their 
hatred  to  Popery  was  so  great,  that  they 
could  not  endure  to  see  an  'orate  pro 
animd,'  or  even  a  cross,  over  a  monument 
without  defacing  it ;  but  it  is  plain  that  it 


BEAWLING 

was  more  the  poor  lucre  of  the  brass,  than 
zeal,  which  tempted  these  miscreants  to 
this  act,  for  there  was  no  gravestone  which 
had  an  inscription  cut  on  itself  that  was 
defaced  by  anything  but  age  throughout 
this  whole  church." 

■  BllAWLINGr,  may  be  generally  defined 
as  behaving  improperly  in  a  church  or 
churchyard,  and  as  far  as- laymen  are  con- 
cerned, who  can  no  longer  be  proceeded 
against  in  the  ecclesiastical  court  for  it,  it  is, 
by  the  latest  Act,  23  &24  Vict.  c.  32,  which 
partly  adopts  the  words  of  much  older  ones, 
"  being  guilty  of  riotous,  violent,  or  indecent 
behaviour  in  any  church  or  chapel  or  church- 
yard, whether  during  divine  service  or  at 
any  other  time ;,  or  molesting,  disturbing, 
vexing,  or  troubling  any  preacher  or  clergy- 
man ministering  there";  and  the  offender 
on  conviction  before  two  justices  may  be 
either  fined  up  to  £5,  or  at  their  discretion 
imprisoned  for  two  months.  And  that 
applies  to  clergymen  as  well  as  laymen. 
The  earliest  of  those  Acts  was  5  &  6  Ed.  VI. 
c.  4,  and  is  not  repealed.  It  enacts  that  "  if 
any  person  shall  by  words  only,  quarrel, 
chide,  or  brawl  in  any  church  or  churchyard, 
it  shall  be  lawful  for  the  oi-dinary  ....  to 
suspend  him,  if  a  clerk,  from  his  ministra- 
tion for  so  long  as  he  shall  think  fit : "  the 
words  about  laymen  are  now  repealed.  But 
both  Lord  Stowell  and  Sir  H.  Jenner  said 
that  this  was  only  a  new  enactment  of 
penalties  for  what  was  already  the  general 
ecclesiastical  law,  and  that  a  clerk  might  be 
proceeded  against  under  either.  In  the 
latest  reported  case,  Langley  v.  Burder  on 
appeal  to  the  P.  0.  (Ecc.  Judgments,  40) 
they  affirmed  a  suspension  for  8  months  for 
delivering  an  irregular  speech  before  a  ser- 
mon, though  it  was  not  directed  at  any 
person  by  name.  That  was  the  first  case 
under  the  Clergy  Discipline  Act  of  1840. 

It  is  impossible  to  say  before  the 
question  is  tried,  how  far  the  common 
law  judges  will  •  interpret  the  words 
"indecent  conduct"  to  extend:  whether 
they  will  hold  it  to  mean  any  conduct 
unbecoming  in  a  church,  having  regard  to 
its  proper  uses,  or  confine  it  to  the  mere 
technical  meaning  of  "indecency."  The 
question  is  left  open  with  the  usual  careless- 
ness of  modem  ecclesiastical  legislation. 
TTie  penalty  on  laymen  for  brawling  in  the 
destroyed  ecclesiastical  jurisdiction  really 
consisted  in  the  costs,  which  appear  some- 
times to  have  been  ten  or  twelve  times  the 
extreme  penalty  of  the  recent  Act,  and 
might  be  enforced  by  imprisonment  under  a 
significavit.  Any  misuse  of  a  church  could 
doubtless  be  restrained  by  the  ecclesiastical 
court  independently  of  brawling,  as  churches 
only  exist  for  the  performance  of  divine 
service  according  to  the  Prayer  Book  by 


BREVIARY 


109 


the  Acts  of  Uniformity.  The  short  service 
Act  allows  no  other  prayers,  nor  anything 
except  seimons.  The  legality  of  a  layman 
giving  lectures  in  Westminster  Abbey,  when 
Dean  Stanley  once  allowed  it,  was  disputed 
in  a  controversy  in  the  Times,  and  the  ex- 
periment was  not  relocated.  Architectural 
lectures  on  and  in  a  church  under  rei^air, 
have  been  frequently  given  without  ques- 
tion, and  can  hardly  be  less  legal  than  the 
talking  of  or  to  the  workmen.  Such  things 
would  probably  be  decided  according  to 
common  sense,  and  the  hona  fides  of  the 
proceeding,  as  some  other  ecclesiastical  suits 
have  been.  [G.] 
BREAD.  (See  Wafer  Bread.) 
BREVIARY.  An  arrangement  of  certain 
divine  offices,  comprising  prayers,  hymi>s, 
psalms,  and  canticles,  with  readings  from 
the  Holy  Scriptures,  and  the  writings  of  the 
Fathers.  Other  terms  to  signify  the  same 
arrangement  were  "  Ofiicium  Divinum  " ; 
or  "  Canonicum  " ;  "HorMCanonicaj"  ;  and 
sometimes  "  Cursus  "  (Wilkins,  Cone.  tom.  i. 
147).  The  first  mention  of  the  word  Breviary, 
with  this  signification,  is  in  Micrologus  ;  the 
author  of  which  treatise  wrote  about  1080. 
He  speaks  of  matters  to  which  "  in  antiquis 
brevariis  reperimus."  This  "  dbhreviation" 
or  re-arrangement  was  at  that  very  time 
being  carried  out  by  Gregory  VII.  (1070- 
1086).  Changes  afterwards  were  made  in 
different  places,  but  not  such  as  to  affect 
the  structure  or  design  of  the  work ;  and  in 
1566  Pope  Pius  V.  ordered  a  number  of 
learned  and  able  men  to  re-arrange  the 
Breviary.  By  his  bull,  Quod  a  nobis,  July 
1568,  he  sanctioned  it,  and  commanded  the 
use  thereof  to  the  clergy  of  the  Roman 
Catholic  Church  all  over  the  world.  Cle- 
ment VIII.,  in  1602,  finding  that  the 
Breviary  of  Pius  V.  had  been  altered  and 
depraved,  restored  it  to  its  pristine  state ; 
and  ordered,  under  pain  of  excommunica- 
tion, that  all  future  editions  should  strictly 
follow  that  which  he  then  printed  at  the 
Vatican.  Lastly,  Urban  VIII.,  in  1631, 
had  the  language  of  the  whole  work,  and 
the  metres  of  the  hymns,  revised, 

The  "  Reformed  Roman  Breviary "  of 
Quignonez,  or  Quignonius,  must  be  noticed, 
because^  although  it  was  afterwards  abolished 
by  Pius  V.  as  not  "  proving  a  prescription 
of  200  year.i,"  it  was,  nevertheless,  ap- 
parently used  by  our  Reformers.  It  set  the 
example  of  compression,  and  also  to  some 
extent  of  method,  in  the  services.  In  it  the 
ancient  confession  and  absolution  are  re- 
moved to  the  beginning  of  the  daily  services, 
and  a  system  of  two  lessons,  on  ordinary  or 
ferial  days,  the  one  from  the  Old,  the  other 
from  the  New  Testament,  is  established. 
(See  Concerningthe  Service.')  Of  this  Breviary 
there  are  six  copies  in  the  Bodleian,  and  one 


110 


BRIEFS 


eacli  in  the  British  Museum,  the  Eouth 
Library  of  Durham,  the  PubUc  Library  at 
Cambridge,  and  Queen's  College,  Oxford. 

The  Breviary,  or  Portiforium  of  Sarum, 
\vas  arranged  from  old  sources  by  Osmund, 
bishop  of"  Salisbury,  and  adopted  in  that 
diocese  in  1085.  It  came  close,  therefore, 
after  Gregory's  "  abbreviation."  Afterwards, 
■with  the  Missal,  it  was  generally  used  in 
the  Church  of  England,  and  was  called  the 
Sarum  Use.  (See  Use.)  The  York  Breviary 
was  very  similar  (Bodleian  Lib.  Venet.  Ed. 
A.D.  1493).  An  account  of  the  Breviary 
"ad  usum  Sarum,"  is  given  in  Haskell's 
Monumenta  Bitualia  Ecdes.  Anglicans, 
from  whose  work  we  quote  the  following : 
"  People  have  been  apt  to  think  that  a  mere 
saying,  however  hurried  and  formal,  of  the 
daily  service  was  held  to  be  sufficient. 
Nothing  can  be  farther  from  the  truth. 
No  less  before  the  middle  of  the  16th  century, 
than  after  it,  the  Church  was  anxious  to 
impress  upon  the  minds  of  both  her  clergy 
and  her  people,  the  absolute  necessity  of 
earnest  devotion — a  worshipping  not  with 
the  mouth  only,  but  the  heart  also." — 
Maskell,  as  quoted  above ;  Seager's  Portifo- 
rium ;  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.    [H.] 

BRIEFS  (see  Bulls)  are  (1)  pontifical 
letters  issued  from  the  court  of  Rome,  sealed 
in  red  wax,  with  the  seal  of  the  fisherman's 
ring :  they  are  written  in  Roman  characters, 
and  subscribed  by  the  secretary  of  briefs, 
who  is  a  secretary  of  state  (usually  either  a 
bishop  or  a  cardinal),  required  to  be  well 
versed  in  the  legal  style  of  papal  documents, 
-and  in  the  sacred  canons.  (2)  The  word 
Brief,  in  our  Prayer  Book,  signifies  the 
sovereign's  letters  patent,  authorising  a 
collection  for  a  charitable  piu:pose;  or,  as 
they  are  now  styled,  Queen's  letters.  These 
are  directed  to  be  read  among  the  notices 
after  the  Nicene  Creed.  They  were  very 
general  in  the  seventeenth  century,  and 
mention  of  them  is  found  in  many  parish 
registers.  For  example,  in  the  register  of 
Porlock,  Somerset,  such  entries  as  these 
■occur:  "Anno  doi  1662  collected  for  the 
Protestant  churches  in  Lithuania,  whose 
deputy  was  John  Kramo  Kramski,  8s.  8p. 
left  in  the  hands  of  Andrew  Kent.  H.  C." 
"  For  Mrs.  Darmond,  the  wife  of  Dr.  Dar- 
mond  in  Ireland,  5s."  For  the  "  sad  fire  in 
London,"  for  the  "redemption  of  slaves  in 
Algeria,"  briefs  were  issued.  But  the  process 
was  inconvenient  and  costly,  and  Acts  were 
passed  to  improve  it  (4  Anne,  9  Geo.  IV.). 
Briefs  may  stiE  be  issued  by  the  Crown,  but 
there  have  been  none  since  1854,     [H.l 

BRITIUS,  OR  BRICE,  BISHOP.  Com- 
memorated on  Nov.  13.  He  was  a  native  of 
Tours,  and  afterwards  bishop  of  that  city, 
succeeding  St.  Martin.     He  died  in  444. 

BROACH.     In  strictness  any  spire,  but 


BURIAL 

generally  used  to  signify  a  spire,  the  junction 
of  which  with  the  tower  is  not  marked  by  a 
parapet,  and  consequently  wider  and  blunter 
than  spires  with  a  parapet  on  the  tower. 
Lancet  and  Geometrical  spires  are  generally 
thus  treatad;  Decorated,  frequently;  Per- 
pendicular, rarely. 

BULL,  in  Cosna  Domini.  This  is  the 
name  given  to  a  bull  in  the  Church  of  Rome, 
which  is  publicly  read  on  the  day  of  the 
Lord's  supper,  viz.  Holy  Thursday,  by  a 
cardinal  deacon  in  the  pope's  presence, 
accompanied  with  the  other  cardinals  and 
the  bishops.  It  was  probably  originated  by 
Boniface  VIII.,  and  contained  an  excom- 
munication against  heretics;  but  it  was 
altered  by  Urban  V.  (a.d.  1364)  so  as  to 
include  also  all  who  were  "stubborn  and 
disobedient  to  the  holy  see,  whether  emperors, 
kings,  or  dukes."  The  Council  of  Tours,  in 
1510,  declared  the  bull  in  Coena  Domini 
void  in  respect  of  France,  which  has  often 
protested  against  it,  in  what  relates  to  the 
king's  prerogative,  and  the  liberties  of  the 
Galilean  Church  ;  and  there  are  now  but  few 
other  Popish  princes  or  states  that  have 
much  regard  to  it.  In  1773  Clement  XIV. 
stopped  the  annual  publication  of  the  bull ; 
but  it  is  considered  by  Romanists  as  still  in 
force. — ^Ranke's  Popes,  xiii.  326 ;  Blunt's 
Diet.  Doct.  Theol.  132. 

BULLS  (see  Briefs)  are  pontifical  letters, 
in  the  Romish  Church,  written  in  old  Gothic 
characters  upon  stout  and  coarse  skins,  and 
issued  from  the  apostolic  chancery,  under  a 
seal  (bulla)  of  lead ;  which  seal  gives  validity 
to  the  document,  and  is  attached,  if  it  be  a 
"Butt  of  Grace;'  by  a  cord  of  silk ;  and,  if 
it  be  a  "Bull  of  Justice,"  by  a  cord  of  hemp. 

The  seal  of  the  fisherman's  ring  cor- 
responds, in  some  degree,  with  the  privy 
seal ;  and  the  lulla,  or  seal  of  lead,  with  the 
great  seal  of  England. 

The  hvUa  is,  properly,  a  seal  of  empire. 
The  imperial  lulla  is  of  gold ;  and  it  was 
under  a  seal  of  this  description  that  King 
John  resigned  the  Crown  of  England  to  the 
pope. 

Bulls  are  more  important  than  briefs,  and 
put  forth  with  more  solemnity ;  but  both  are 
equally  acts  of  the  pope,  though  issued 
from  different  departments  of  the  pontiff's 
government. 

BURIAL.  (See  Cemetery,  Dead.)  Chris- 
tians in  the  first  centuries  used  to  bury 
their  dead  in  the  places  used  also  by  the 
heathen,  in  caves  or  vaults  by  the  wayside, 
or  in  fields  out  of  their  cities.  The  heathen 
used  to  burn  the  bodies  of  .the  dead,  but  the 
patriarchs  and  Jews  buried  them,  and  then 
restored  the  older  and  better  practice  of 
laying  the  remains  decently  in  the  earth. 
Their  persecutors,  knowing  their  feelings  on 
this  subject,  of  ten.  endeavoured  to  prevent 


BURIAL 

them  from  burying  their  dead,  by  burning 
the  bodies  of  their  martyrs,  as  they  did  that 
of  Polycarp,  bishop  of  Smyrna;  or  by 
tlirowing  their  ashes  into  rivers,  as  tliey  did 
those  of  the  martyrs  of  Lyons  and  Vienne  in 
France,  a.d.  177.  And  although  the  heathen 
seemed  to  think  it  unlucky  and  of  evil  omen 
to  perform  their  funerals  by  day,  carrying 
out  their  dead  after  night-fall,  and  by  torch- 
light, the  Christians  used  to  follow  their 
deceased  friends  to  the  grave,  in  the  light  of 
the  sun,  with  a  large  attendance  of  people 
walking  in  procession,  sometimes  carrying 
candles  in  token  of  joy  and  thanksgiving, 
and  chanting  psalms.  It  was  also  the 
custom,  before  they  went  to  the  grave,  to 
assemble  in  the  church,  where  the  body  was 
laid,  and  a  funeral  sermon  was  sometimes 
preached.  The  holy  communion  was  ad- 
ministered on  these  occasions  to  the  friends 
of  the  deceased,  for  which  a  service,  with  an 
appropriate  Collect,  Epistle,  and  Gospel,  was 
set  forth  in  our  own  Church  in  the  First 
Book  of  King  Edward  VI.,  and  in  the  reign 
of  Queen  Elizabeth,  a.d.  1560.  The  office 
for  the  Burial  of  the  Dead  used  by  the 
English  Church  corresponds  with  the  offices 
of  the  primitive  Church,  particularly  as 
regards  the  psalms,  the  anthem,  "  Man  that 
is  born  of  a  woman,"  &c.,  and  the  portions 
of  Scripture  appointed  to  be  read. 

By  the  operation  of  several  recent  Acts, 
practically  no  burial  can  now  take  place  in 
churches  without  leave  from  the  Secretary 
of  State,  except  a  very  few,  such  as  West- 
minster Abbey,  and  occasionally  where  a 
burying-place  within  the  church  is  prescribed 
for  as  belonging  to  a  manor  house.  By  the 
common  law  of  England,  any  person  may  be 
buried  in  the  churchyard  of  the  parish 
where  he  dies,  without  paying  anything  for 
breaking  the  soil,  unless  a  fee  is  payable  by 
prescription,  or  immemorial  usage.  But 
ordinarily  a  person  may  not  be  buried  in  the 
churchyard  of  another  parish  than  that 
wherein  he  died,  at  least  without  the  consent 
of  the  churchwardens,  whose  parochial  right 
of  burial  is  invaded  thereby,  and  also  of  the 
incumbent  whose  soil  is  broken ;  but  where 
a  person  dies  on  his  journey  or  otherwise,  out 
of  the  parish,  or  where  there  is  a  family 
vault  or  burial-place  in  the  church,  or 
chancel,  or  aisle  of  such  other  parish,  it  may 
be  otherwise.  Burial  cannot  be  legally 
refused  to  dead  bodies  on  account  of  debt, 
even  although  the  debtor  was  confined  in 
prison  at  the  time  of  his  death. 

By  canon  68.  "  No  minister  shall  refuse 
or  delay  to  bury  any  corpse  that  is  brought 
to  the  church  or  churchyard  (convenient 
warning  being  given  him  thereof  before), 
in  such  manner  and  form  as  is  prescribed  m 
the  Book  of  Common  Prayer.  And  if  he 
fihaU   refuse  so  to  do,  except    the  party 


BURIAL 


111 


deceased  were  denounced  excommunicated 
inajori  excommunicatione,  for  some  grievous 
and  notorious  crime  (and  no  man  able  to 
testify  of  his  repentance),  he  shall  be  sus- 
pended by  the  bishop  of  the  diocese  from  his 
ministry  by  the  space  of  three  months."  But 
by  the  rubric  before  the  office  for  Burial  of 
the  Dead,  the  said  office  likewise  shall  not 
be  used  for  any  that  die  unbaptized,  or  that 
have  laid  violent  hands  upon  themselves ; 
and  this  is  not  affected  by  the  Act  of 
1882,  which  permits  suicides  to  be  buried  in 
churchyards  instead  of  in  the  highway,  but 
makes  no  alteration  in  the  law  of  the  Prayer 
Book,  so  that  a  clergyman  may  still  not  read 
the  service  over  them,  but  anybody  else  may, 
under  the  Act  of  1880,  which  has  effaced  most 
of  the  difi'erences  between  consecrated  and 
unconsecrated  burial  grounds.  It  is  difficult, 
if  not  impossible,  to  say  yet  how  some 
questions  will  be  decided  arising  from  that 
Act,  together  with  others,  and  especially  one 
of  the  preceding  year.  The  whole  series  of 
Burial  Acts  have  laecome  a  mass  of  confusion, 
which  is  increased  rather  than  diminished 
by  every  new  one.  Different  laws  apply  to 
what  Lord  Campbell  conveniently  designated 
"  commercial  cemeteries,"  and  public  ones. 
B.  V.  Manchester  Justices  (5  Ell.  &  Bl.  70^, 
25  L.  J.,  M.  C.  45).  Ko  one  knows  yet 
whether  cemeteries  established  by  town 
councils  or  boards  of  health  at  the  cost  of 
the  ratepayers,  under  the  Act  of  1879,  will  be 
held  to  be  public  burial  grounds  in  which  all 
persons  within  their  district  have  a  right  to 
be  buried ;  and  then  whether  they  are  to 
be  legally  regarded  as  parochial  burying 
grounds,  or  whether  the  board  can  thereupon 
be  made  a  burial  board.  So  far  as  they  are 
decided  to  be  public  burial  grounds,  they 
will  come  under  the  Act  of  1880 ;  but  that 
Act  expressly  gives  no  right  of  being  buried 
(in  any  given  place)  to  any  one  who  has  it  not 
aliunde.  Such  grounds  are  put  by  the  Act 
of  1879  under  the  Cemeteries  Clauses  Act, 
which  contemplates  consecration  of  at  least 
some  portion  of  the  ground,  and  also  under 
the  Public  Health  Act,  1875. 

The  Act  of  1880  gives  no  new  right  to  be 
buried  in  any  consecrated  ground,  but  only 
the  right  to  be  buried  there,  i.e.  in  any 
public  graveyard  (not  that  of  a  commercial 
cemetery  company,  or  private  trustees),  with 
any  decent  and  orderly  Christian  service 
performed  by  anybody,  or  without  any 
service  at  all,  on  giving  forty-eight  hours' 
notice  to  the  incumbent  or  chaplain,  who 
may  object  to  the  time  proposed  as  in- 
convenient, and  arrange  another  time,  and  he 
may  absolutely  prohibit  such  burials  on 
Sunday,  Christmas  Day,  or  Good  Friday. 
On  the  other  hand,  clergymen  may  now 
perform  the  burial  service  in  unconsecrated 
ground,  and  use  any  other  burial  service 


112 


BUEIAL 


consisting  only  of  prayers  in  the  Prayer 
Book,  and  portions  of  the  Bible  approved  by 
the  ordinary,  and  "  at  the  request  of  the 
person  having  the  charge  of  the  burial,"  who 
may  be  the  undertaker,  or  somebody  much 
worse,  who  is  thus  put  in  the  position  of 
joint  ordinary  with  the  bishop  for  a  church 
funeral,  but  for  no  other— a  very  pretty 
specimen  of  modem  legislation  for  the 
Church. 

Sect.  9  excepts  grounds  vested  in  trustees 
(who  have  the  right  of  prescribing  "  express 
conditions  for  interment ")  and  any  ground 
not  being  the  burial  ground  of  the  parish 
where  it  is,  which  apparently  enables  ground 
to  be  so  vested  on  a  condition  that  only 
funerals  of  a  particular  kind  may  be  per- 
formed there :  and  there  is  nothing  to  prevent 
such  ground  from  being  consecrated — what- 
ever that  now  means.  The  incumbent  or  the 
cemetery  authority  is  to  register  the  funeral 
with  the  name  only  of  "  the  person  who  had 
charge  of  it,"  and  who  is  also  to  send  the 
notice,  except  where  it  is  performed  by 
the  incumbent  himself.  The  "convenient 
warning"  under  the  68th  canon  means 
reasonably  convenient  for  the  clergyman, 
which  must  be  decided  according  to  all  the 
circumstances.  (Titchmarsh  v.  Chapman, 
1  Bob.  175.) 

There  is  nothing  in  any  of  the  Acts  to 
prevent,  and  s.  9  of  1880  recognises  the  right 
for  any  private  person,  or  a  few  trustees, 
or  even  an  incumbent  from  holding  land 
for  the  purpose  of  burying  there,  with  any 
rites  that  they  choose  to  specify  in  the  trust. 
Probably  the  burial  grounds  attached  to  some 
Quakers'  and  other  meeting-houses  have 
always  been  held  in  that  way.  And  now 
that  clergymen  are  at  liberty  to  perform  the 
burial  service  of  the  Church  anywhere,  there 
seems  no  reason  why  land  may  not  be  added 
to  the  churchyard  on  a  special  trust,  taking 
care  not  to  have  it  legally  consecrated,  or  it 
will  become  a  parochial  churchyard.  A 
mere  religious  service  by  the  bishop  is  not 
consecration  in  the  legal  sense,  and  gives 
no  new  rights  to  anybody.  Indeed,  it  is 
difficult  to  say  what  legal  consecration  of  a 
burial  ground  now  does,  except  giving  the 
right  to  everybody  dying  in  the  parish  to  be 
buried  there.  Formerly  it  meant  that  no 
body  could  be  buried  there  except  with  a 
church  funeral,  and  conversely  no  clergyman 
could  bury  in  any  ground  not  consecrated. 
Now  both  those  limitations  are  effaced. 
Consequently,  several  bishops  have  assumed 
that  they  will  "  consecrate  "  no  more  ceme- 
teries. The  consecration  of  churches  is  a 
different  matter.  A  chapel  built  on  the 
consecrated  part  of  a  cemetery  is  not  a 
church,  and  consecration  of  the  ground 
on  which  it  stands  does  not  make  it  the 
freehold  of  the  parson,  as  the  consecration  of 


BUEIAL 

a  church  does,  except  private  chapels  exempt 
by  ancient  laws  or  certain  modem  Acts. 

The  only  persons  who  have  an  absolute 
right  to  be  buried  in  a  churchyard  are  those 
who  die  in  the  parish,  wherever  they  come 
from,  except  in  private  graves  reserved  under 
Acts  or  faculties.  And  it  has  been  several 
times  laid  down  that  the  parson  has  uo 
right  to  bury  strangers  without  the  consent 
of  the  churchwardens,  who  ought  to  have 
regard  to  the  capacity  of  the  unoccupied 
ground  and  the  probable  future  wants  of  the 
parishioners. 

A  multitude  of  Acts  about  burials  and 
cemeteries  have  been  passed  in  this  century, 
besides  those  technically  called  Private  Acts 
for  establishing  commercial  cemeteries  (as 
Lord  Campbell  called  them)  in  the  hands  of 
companies  which  are  now  no  longer  needed ; 
various  local  and  parochial  authorities  can 
provide  them  either  jointly  (under  9  &  10 
Vict.  c.  68)  or  separately.  The  "  Cemeteries 
Clauses  Act,  1847,"  contains  the  clauses 
which  used  to  be  in  all  the  cemetery 
companies'  Acts,  and  it  is  now  incorporated 
into  the  general  Acts  of  1879 — a  very  short 
one,  but  very  important ;  for  it  authorises 
all "  local  authorities  "  to  establish  cemeteries 
as  if  they  had  been  included  in  the  Public 
Health  Act,  1875,  and  subject  to  the  Ceme- 
teries Clauses  Act,  but  with  no  provision 
whatever  about  fees,  or  to  prevent  them 
from  starting  an  unlimited  competition  out 
of  the  public  rates  against  every  other 
churchyard  or  burial  ground  within  reach : 
which  had  all  been  carefully  provided  against 
before  by  s.  35  of  15  &  16  Vict.  c.  85,  which 
was  extended  from  London  to  all  England 
in  the  following  year,  1853. 

Those  two  Acts,  and  another  in  1854, 
established  burial  boards,  which  are  now 
generally  the  town  council  or  the  local 
authority  of  any  district.  The  first  step  is 
that  the  Queen  in  Council,  on  the  represen- 
tation of  any  town  council,  &c.,  may  order 
any  parochial  burial  ground  to  be  closed 
wholly  or  partially  for  the  protection  of 
public  health,  and  then  may  constitute  the 
town  council  a  burial  board  for  the  borough, 
&c.,  and  for  the  whole  of  the  parishes  wholly 
or  partly  within  the  borough ;  and  then  it 
may  provide  new  ground,  of  which  it  might 
be  generally  said  that  part  was  to  be  conse- 
crated and  part  not ;  and  there  were  to  be  two 
chapels,  one  "  on  the  consecrated  ground " 
(which  was  the  only  enactment  about  con- 
secrating the  chapel),  and  the  other  not. 
Higher  burial  fees  may  be  charged  for  parish- 
ioners outside  the  borough,  because  they  do ' 
not  contribute  to  the  borough  rates  (s.  8  of 
1854),  and  there  are  provisions  for  settling 
the  fees  payable  to  incumbents  with  the 
approval  of  the  bishop  (s.  10).  They  have 
the  right  to  bury  their  own  parishioners ;  and 


BUEIAJj 

there  are  provisions  to  prevent  the  hoard 
from  Tinderhidding  the  settled  clerical  fees  hy 
lower  ones  in  the  unoonsecrated  ground  (s.  17 
of  1857).  Another  curious  provision  of  that 
Act  is  that  church  funerals  may  be  performed 
in  ground  that  is  only  intended  to  be  con- 
secrated, by  licence  only,  of  the  bishop  in 
some  cases,  and,  if  he  refuses,  by  that  of  the 
archbishop,  and  even  of  the  Secretary  of 
State,  for  a  time  which  may  be  indefinite 
(ss.^  12, 13).  There  are  many  other  provisions 
which  it  is  impossible  to  describe  here  in 
that  confused  series  of  chiefly  Burial  Board 
Acts  of  1853,  4,  5,  7,  9,  60,  62,  71,  79,  80, 
the  mere  enumeration  of  which  is  enough  to 
prove  the  carelessness  with  which  they  were 
all  framed  and  passed. 

Then  there  are  the  various  registration 
Acts,  and  odd  clauses  about  registration  in 
Acts  mostly  about  other  things.  It  is  well 
known  that  all  funerals  have  to  be  registered 
at  the  churchyard  or  cemetery  where  they 
are  performed.  And  by  the  Public  Health 
Act,  1875,  as  by  a  former  one,  the  person 
who  performs  a  funeral  service  anywhere 
without  the  certificate  or  a  coroner's  order, 
which  ought  to  be  given  to  him,  must  notify 
the  same  to  the  registrar  of  the  district  under 
a  penalty  of  £10.  Dead  children  must  not 
be  buried  as  still-born,  nor  still-bom  ones 
mthout  a  proper  certificate  or  declaration 
as  the  Act  provides.  It  has  been  decided 
several  times  that  a  corpse  belongs  to  nobody, 
but  it  must  not  be  kept  unburied  so  long  as 
becomes  dangerous  to  health.  Where  they 
are  kept  beyond  a  few  days,  quick-lime 
ought  to  be  put  into  the  coffin,  or  even 
common  earth.  A  lead  "  shell "  is  a  mere 
rmdertaker's  job,  and  only  keeps  up  the 
process  of  putrefaction  as  long  as  possible, 
while  earth  at  once  begins  the  process  of 
cremation  innoxiously,  if  there  is  plenty  of 
it.  Brick  graves  ought  to  be  prohibited  for 
the  same  reason.  Bodies  once  buried  may 
not  be  removed  without  a  faculty  from  the 
diocesan  court,  in  churchyards  or  parochial 
cemeteries,  or  a  licence  from  the  Secretary  of 
State  elsewhere ;  and  it  is  a  criminal  offence 
to  do  so.  It  should  be  understood  that  no 
payment  for  making  vaults  or  brick  graves 
in  a  churchyard  can  confer  any  future  right 
of  burial  there;  nor  can  people  choose  their 
place  for  burying.  In  cemeteries  graves 
may  be  purchased.  Lastly,  tenants  for  life, 
as  well  as  owners  in  fee,  may  give  land  for 
enlarging  a  churchyard  by  30  &  31  Vict. 
c.  133 ;  and  by  that  Act,  and  c.  47  of  the 
following  year,  they  may  reserve  a  sixth,  or 
fifty  square  yards,  for  their  own  family. 

The  rubric  directs  that  the  priests  and 
clerks  meeting  the  corpse  at  the  entrance  of 
the  churchyard,  and  going  before  it,  either 
into  the  church  or  towards  the  grave,  shall 
say  or  sing  as  is  there  appointed.    By  which 


BUKIAL 


113 


it  seems  to  be  discretionary  in  the  minister, 
whether  the  corpse  shall  be  carried  into  the 
church  or  not.  And  there  may  be  good 
reason  for  not  bringing  it  into  the  church, 
especially  in  cases  of  infection. 

Canon  67.  After  the  party's  death  there 
shall  be  rung  no  more  than  one  short  peal, 
and  one  before  the  burial,  and  one  other  after 
the  burial.  The  ringing  of  one  bell  on  a 
death  is  called  the  Passing  bell.  (See  Passing 
Bell).  After  the  funeral,  if  a  peal  is  rung  at 
all,  the  bells  are  "  muffled  "  by  tying  leather 
round  the  clappers  on  one  or  both  sides,  to 
make  them  sound  soft. 

A  corpse  belongs  to  no  one,  but  is  subject 
to  ecclesiastical  cognizance,  if  abused  or 
removed ;  and  a  corpse,  once  buried,  cannot 
be  taken  up  or  removed  without  licence  from 
the  ordinary,  or  the  Secretary  of  State,  if  it 
is  to  be  buried  in  another  place,  or  the 
like ;  but  in  the  case  of  a  violent  death,  the 
coroner  may  take  up  the  body  for  his  in- 
spection, if  it  is  interred  before  he  comes  to 
view  it.     [G-.] 

The  Order  for  the  Burial  of  the  Dead  is 
much  modified  from  the  service  in  the  First 
Book  of  King  Edward  VI.  The  psalms  were 
the  116th,  139th,  and  146th:  the  prayers 
were  in  many  respects  different ;  and  there 
are  certain  passages  omitted  in  the  Second 
Book.  The  psalms  in  the  First  Book  were 
omitted  in  the  subsequent  revisals,  and  the 
lesson  was  recited  after  the  anthem,  "  I  heard 
a  voice  from  heaven : "  and  the  present  psalms 
were  not  inserted  till  the  last  Review. 

BURIAL  FEES  are  in  a  very  anomalous 
and  unsatisfactory  state.  Theoretically,  and 
by  various  old  laws,  no  fees  were  payable  for 
mere  burying.  But  in  those  days  there  were 
"mortuaries,"  and  other  payments  to  the 
clergy.  And  the  law  now  is  that  customary 
burial  fees  are  payable  in  old  parishes,  and 
fees  fixed  by  the  chancellor  of  the  diocese  in 
new  ones  under  6  &  7  Vict.  c.  37.  But  it 
seems  very  doubtful  if  there  is  any  legal 
power  to  vary  them  in  either  case^  though 
Lord  Stowell  did  so,  after  deciding  the  case 
of  OiTbert  v.  Buzzard  (3  Phil.  335)  about 
iron  coffins,  for  which  he  allowed  a  larger 
fee.  But  a  further  anomaly  is  that  the 
ecclesiastical  court  cannot  try  the  custom  if 
it  is  denied,  and  the  common  law  courts  are 
not  the  proper  ones  to  sue  in  for  burial  fees  ; 
and  yet  further,  the  clergyman  has  no  right 
to  stay  the  funeral  until  the  fees  are  paid, 
however  undisputed  their  amount  may  be, 
though  he  can  prevent  gravestones  until  the 
fee  is  paid  for  them.  (See  Graves.)  The 
whole  of  the  law  on  this  subject  requires 
consolidating  and  revising,  but  probably  the 
opportunity  wouldbe taken  to  rob  the  Church 
still  more,  as  in  fact  a  committee  of  the 
House  of  Commons  recommended  in  1882. 
In  special  cemetery  Acts  provision  is  gene- 


114 


BUTTKESS 


CABBALAH 


rally  made  for  the  fees  payable  to  the 
inoumbents;  and  the  general  "Cemeteries 
Clauses  Act  of  1847  "  enacts  that  such  fees 
shall  be  paid  to  them  as  the  special  Acts 
provide.  Tlie  Act  of  15  Vict.  c.  85,  extended 
to  all  towns  by  16  Vict.  c.  134,  making 
further  provision  for  cemeteries  and  burial 
boards,  requires  the  fees  payable  to  the 
clergy  to  be  settled  by  the  vestry  and  the 
bishop,  or  if  none  are  so  settled,  then  the 
customary  fees  are  to  be  paid  in  respect  of 
selling  any  exclusive  right  of  burial  (which 
the  clergy  have  no  power  to  do),  and  con- 
structiug  vaults,  and  placing  stones,  which 
they  have  power  to  do.  The  Act  strangely 
omits  the  consent  of  the  incumbent,  and 
there  is  a  famous  case  where  Bishop  Blom- 
field  allowed  the  value  of  a  metropolitan 
living  to  be  almost  destroyed  by  making 
such  a  "  settlement"  without  even  consulting 
the  incumbent,  or  inquiring  what  were  the 
established  fees  for  burying  in  the  vaults 
under  the  church. 

Several  church-building  Acts  reserve  the 
rights  for  life  of  the  incumbents  of  old 
parishes  out  of  which  new  ones  are  carved, 
and  afterwards  the  fees  arising  in  the  new 
parishes  go  to  their  incumbents.  (See 
Banns.')  The  Public  Health  Act  authorises 
local  boards  to  establish  mortuaries — not 
fees,  but  places  to  keep  dead  bedies  waiting 
for  burial.  And  another  Act  which  passed 
almost  unnoticed  in  1879,  called  the  Public 
Health  Interments  Act,  enabled  them  also 
to  establish  cemeteries  either  within  or 
without  their  district,  subject  to  the  Ceme- 
teries Clauses  Act,  1847,  and  the  Public 
Health  Act,  1875,  and  with  no  special 
provision  about  fees :  which  may  cause  some 
litigation.     [G.] 

BUTTRESS.  An  external  support  to  a 
wall,  so  arranged  as  to  counteract  the  lateral 
thrust  of  roofs  and  vaulting. 

The  buttress  is  not  used  in  Classic  archi- 
tecture where  the  thrust  is  always  vertical ; 
and  in  Romanesque  it  is  hardly  developed. 
It  is,  in  fact,  a  correlative  of  the  pointed 
arch,  especially  when  used  in  vaulting,  and 
so  first  attains  considerable  depth  in  the 
Lancet  period.  In  the  later  periods,  when  it 
had  to  support  vaulting  of  vast  expanse  and 
weight,  its  depth  or  projection  was  pro- 
portionably  increased. 

A  flying  huttress  is  a  half  arch  carrying 
the  thrust  of  a  vault  beyond  the  clearstory 
wall,  which  only  rests  on  pillars,  over  the 
aisle  roof  to  the  main  buttresses,  and  so  to 
the  ground  :  or  any  similar  construction.  Or, 
more  accurately,  they  are,  or  ought  to  be,  a 
stone  beam  supported  by  the  half  arch,  with 
the  joints  at  right  angles  to  the  beam. 

The  pinnacles  which  frequently  termi- 
nate buttresses  are  intended  to  add  to  the 
weight  of  the  supporting  mass.' 


o. 


CABBALAH,  or  KABBALAH,  (n^ao)- 
The  name  is  derived  from  ^30,  to  receive, 
and  implies  a  doctrine  received  by  oral  tradi- 
tion. This  mysterious  teaching,  according  to 
the  Cabbalists,  is  of  praj-Adamite  existence. 
God  Himself,  they  say,  taught  it  first  to  a 
select  company  of  angels,  who,  after  the  fall, 
communicated  it  to  the  disobedient  child  of 
earth,  to  supply  the  means  of  returning  to 
the  pristine  state  of  happiness  and  com- 
munion with  the  Deity.  Prom  Adam  it 
was  handed  down  to  Noah,  Abraham,  and 
afterwards  to  Moses,  who  laid  down  the 
principles  of  it  in  the  first  four  books  of  the 
Pentateuch.  Moses  initiated  the  70  elders 
into  its  secrets,  and  they  were  transmitted 
in  an  unbroken  line  to  David,  Solomon, 
&c.,  tiU  the  time  of  the  destruction  of 
Jerusalem,  when  Simon  ben  Yochai  was  the 
last  depositary  of  this  tradition.  His  son, 
and  his  disciples,  are  said  to  have  been  the 
compilers  of  the  celebrated  work  called 
Sohar,  that  is,  "  the  Splendour,"  which  is 
the  grand  storehouse  of  Cabbalism.  On  the 
fanciful  ideas  of  the  Cabbalah — the  nature 
of  the  Supreme  Being,  the  emanations  from 
Him,  the  Creation,  the  psychology,  or 
doctrine  about  th/;  nature  of  the  human  soul 
— it  is  not  necessary  here  to  dwell ;  they  are 
concisely  given  in  the  Dictionary  of  Chris- 
tian Biography  (vol.  i.  p.  359,  seq.)  The 
teaching  of  the  Cabbalah  is  founded,  after 
the  oral  tradition,  on  the  arrangement  of 
letters  and  words  in  the  Bible,  according  to 
rules,  something  after  the  fashion  of  an 
acrostic.  Thus  every  letter  of  a  word  is 
reduced  to  its  numerical  value,  and  the  word 
is  explained  by  another  of  the  same  quantity. 
This  is  called  Gematvia.  Or  every  letter  of 
a  word  is  taken  as  the  initial  or  abbreviation 
of  a  word — which  is  called  Notaricon.  Or 
two  words  occurring  in  the  same  verse  are 
joined  together  and  made  into  one  word,  &c. 
It  is,  probably,  to  these  interpretations  of 
the  written  law  our  Saviour's  censure  is  to 
be  apphed,  when  He  reproves  the  Jews  for 
"making  the  commands  of  God  of  none 
effect  through  their  traditions." 

It  is  the  opinion  of  some  that  Pythagoras 
and  Plato  learned  the  Cabbalistic  art  of  the 
Jews  .in  Egypt ;  others,  on  the  contrary, 
say  the  philosophy  of  Pythagoras  and  Plato 
furnished  the  Jews  with  the  Cabbalah. 
Most  of  the  heretics,  in  the  primitive  Chris- 
tian Church,  fell  into  the  vain  conceits  of 
the  Cabbalah;  particularly  the  Gnostics, 
Valentinians,  and  Basilidians. — Franck,  i« 
Cahhale ;  Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  28,  56  • 
Milman's  Hist,  of  Jews,  v.  iii.  431.     [H.] 


CABBALISTS 

CABBALISTa,  or  KABBALISTS.  Those 
Jewish  doctors  w  ho  profess  the  study  of  the 
Cabbalah.  'ihe  chief  Cabbalistic  author  was 
Simon,  son  of  Joachai,  or  Voohai,  referred 
to  above.     (See  Cabbalah.) 

Though  this  mysterious  doctrine  is  of 
peculiarly  Jewish  ojigin,  3-et  it  was  intro- 
duced into  the  Chrisdan  Church;  and  an 
explanation  of  the  secret  which  binds  all 
created  things  togetber,  and  unites  them 
\vith  the  Creator,  was  sought  in  the  Cabbalah 
by  such  distinguished  scholars  as  Lully 
(1235),  Eeuchlin  (1455),  and  our  owq 
countrymen  Fludd  (1574),  and  Henry  More 
(1614).— Dici.  Christ.  Biog.,  &c. 

CAINITES.  An  obscure  sect  of  the 
Gnostics  of  the  second  century,  who  paid 
respect  to  Cain,  Korah,  the  Sodomites,  and 
Judas  the  traitor.  They  are  mentioned 
by  Iren»us  and  other  early  writers. — Iren. 
ad  Hxr.  xxxi. ;  Epiphan.  Hier.  xxxviii. ; 
Ep.  Kayes,  Tertull.  522. 

CMCILIA.  Virgin  and  Martyr;  com- 
memorated in  the  English  Calendar  on 
JNov.  22.  She  suffered  martyrdom  in  the 
Teign  of  Severus.  Cast  into  a  bath  of  boil- 
ing water,  she  took  no  harm ;  and  when  the 
■executioner  was  bidden  to  put  her  to  death, 
he  was  so  much  moved  by  her  patient 
•endurance,  that  ho  would  only  inflict  three 
wounds  upon  her — and  then,  ashamed  of 
himself,  fled.  .  She  survived  for  three  days, 
•singing  hymns  up  to  the  last  moment  of 
her  life.  She  is  regarded  as  the  patron 
saint  of  music ;  and  by  the  old  painters  is 
•generally  depicted  with  a  musical  instru- 
Tnent  in  her  hand.  The  wreath  of  roses, 
which  is  generally  to  be  seen  in  old  pictures 
-of  St.  Caecilia,  refer  to  the  legend  that  her 
betrothed.  Valerian,  had  a  vision,  in  which 
he  saw  an  angel  with  two  crowns  of  roses 
gathered  in  Paradise,  immortal  in  them- 
selves, but  invisible  to  the  eyes  of  unbe- 
lievers, with  which  he  encircled  the  brows 
of  Caecilia  and  Valerian,  as  they  knelt  before 
him. — Alban  Butler's  Lives  of  the  Saints ; 
Smith  and  Wace's  Diet.  Christ.  Biog.   [H.] 

CALENDAR,  from  the  Latin  Calendar- 
ium,  an  account-book  for  debts,  so  called 
because  the  Roman  settling-day  was  the 
Calendm,  or  first  day  of  the  month.  I.  Eccle- 
siastical calendars  are  of  very  early  date, 
■coeval  with  the  commemoration  of  martyrs 
(Euseb.  iv.  15).  One  of  the  middle  of  the 
iburth  century  is  still  extant,  and  others  of 
very  early  date  are  given  by  Martene  (  Vet. 
Scrip,  collect,  vol.  vi.  1724).  The  early  ca- 
lendars were  compiled  mainly  for  the  pur- 
T30se  of  indicating  the  days  on  which  the 
martyrs  and  confessors  of  the  Church  were 
-to  be  commemorated,  but  afterwards  the 
names  of  saints  who  Had  been  canonized 
were  added,  until  there  was  a  vast  accu- 
anulation,  as  may  be  seen   in  the  "  Acta 


CALENDAR 


115 


Sanctorum,"  not  yet  finished. — Bollandus, 
cum  conlinuationibus  Henschenii.,  &c.,  54 
vols.  1734-1861. 

n.  In  England  the  earliest  calendar 
known  is  attributed  with  good  reason  to 
Bode,  who  died  a.d.  735;  and  it  is  printed 
by  Martene  {Vet.  Scrip,  vol.  vi.  635).  In 
the  library  at  Durham  Cathedral  there  is  a 
calendar  of  the  eleventh  or  twelfth  century, 
which  differs  little  from  one  reprinted  from 
a  Missal  of  1514,  which  belonged  to  Bp. 
Cosin's  library.  To  the  English  Calendar, 
during  the  mediaeval  times,  few  names 
were  added,  while  in  the  Roman  Calendar  a 
great  many  were  inserted.  The  multitude 
of  holy  days,  urged  by  the  priests,  en- 
couraged idleness,  and  thus  injured  the  pros- 
perity of  the  countrj'.  In  Henry  VIIL's 
time,  therefore,  the  observance  of  some  of 
these  days  was  abrogated,  and  especially  it 
may  be  noticed  that  two  days  dedicated  to 
St.  Thomas  a  Becket  were  omitted.  In  the 
book  of  1549,  the  calendar  contains  only 
the  chief  names  of  those  mentioned  in  the 
Sarum  Use,  and  in  1552  the  names  of  St. 
Mary  Magdalene  and  St.  Barnabas  were 
struck  out ;  the  latter,  however,  being  pro- 
bably omitted  by  a  printer's  error.  It  was 
restored  in  1559,  and  the  names  of  St. 
George  and  St.  Lawrence  were  added.  In 
1561  a  commission  was  appointed  for  a 
revision  of  the  Calendar,  and  the  "  eves  "  of 
saints'  days  were  noticed.  In  1 661  the  names 
of  two  national  saints  were  added — St.  Alban 
and  the  Venerable  Bede,  and  of  one  Galilean 
bishop,  St.  Eunurchus.  In  the  English 
Calendar  twenty-five  days  are  dedicated  to 
saints  mentioned  in  Holy  Scripture,  or  con- 
nected with  the  life  of  our  Lord;  twenty 
days  are  dedicated  to  martyrs  who  died  for 
the  faith  between  a.d.  90-316  ;  twenty-one 
days  are  dedicated  to  saints  especially  con- 
nected with  the  Church  of  England ;  and 
eleven  days  to  other  saints,  among  whom 
are  the  "  Doctors "  Ambrose,  Jerome,  Au- 
gustine, and  Gregory.  Wheatly  gives  se- 
veral reasons  why  those  minor  festivals 
were  retained  in  our  Prayer  Book. 

III.  Our  calendar  in  the  Prayer  Book 
consists  of  several  columns.  The  first  shows 
the  days  of  the  month  in  their  numerical 
order ;  the  second  contains  the  first  letters  of 
the  alphabet  affixed  to  the  days  of  the  week ; 
called  the  Sunday  Letter ;  so  that  the  letter 
for  each  year  denotes  all  the  Sundays  therein. 
The  third,  as  printed  in  the  larger  Common 
Prayer  Books,  (as  it  ought  to  be  in  all,) 
has  the  calends,  nones,  and  ides,  which 
was  the  method  of  computation  used  by  the 
old  Romans  and  primitive  Christians,  and 
is  still  useful  to  those  who  read  ecclesiastical 
history. 

The  last  four  columns  contain  the  course 
of  lessons  for  morning  and  evening  prayer 

1  2 


116 


CALIXTINES 


for  ordinary  days  throughout  the  year.  The 
intermediate  column,  namely,  the  fourth, 
contains  the  holy  days  observed  hy  the 
Church  of  England. 

A  new  Table  of  Lessons  was  issued  by 
authority  of  Parliament  in  1871,  and  made 
obligatory  from  1879.     (See  Lessons.) 

BytlieActs  24  Geo.  II.  c.  23,  and  25  Geo. 
II.  c.  30,  the  calendar  was  reformed,  and  the 
new  style  introduced.  (See  Sir  E.  Beckett's 
Astronomy  without  Mathematics,  where  an 
explanation  of  the  principles  of  the  change 
of  "  style  "  is  given.)  Until  1752,  the  years 
began  on  March  25,  and  September  3  of 
that  year  was  made  September  14  by  the 
Act.  The  general  tables  at  the  end  of  the 
calendar  in  the  Prayer  Book  for  finding 
Easter  and  Sunday  are  erroneous  before 
the  change  of  style,  and  do  not  enable 
you  to  find  on  what  day  of  the  week  any 
day  fell  while  old  style  prevailed,  and,  a 
fortiori,  any  Easter.  A  proper  table  for 
old  style  is  given  in  the  book  just  men- 
tioned.— Martene,  Veterum  Scriptorum,  &c. ; 
CoUedio,  vol.  vi.  1724 ;  Blunt,  P.  B.  [36]  ; 
Wheatly,  Common  Prayer  Book ;  Diet. 
Christ.  Ant.    [H.] 

CALIXTINES.  I.  A  section  of  the  Hus- 
sites, who  derived  their  name  from  the 
"  cup  "  (calix),  which  they  desired  to  have 
restored  to  all  in  the  Holy  Communion. 
Their  views  were  moderate,  and  in  this 
they  differed  from  another  section  of  Hus- 
sites— the  Taborites — who  demanded  that 
both  religion  and  the  government  of  the 
Church  should  be  restored  to  its  primitive 
simplicity.  The  requirements  of  the  Calix- 
tines  were : — (1)  That  the  word  of  God  might 
be  preached  in  its  purity  and  simplicity  to 
the  people.  (2)  That  the  Communion  might 
be  administered  in  both  kinds.  (3)  That  the 
clergy  might  be  brought  to  a  life  suiting 
the  successors  of  the  Apostles,  and  not  have 
such  wealth  and  power.  (4)  That  the  greater 
or  "  mortal "  sins  might  be  duly  punished. — 
Stubbs'  Mosheim,  ii.  354;  Blunt's  Diet. 
Sects,  p.  95. 

n.  The  name  Calixtines  was  also  given  in 
the  17th  century  to  the  followers  of  George 
Calixtus,  a  celebrated  divine  amongst  the 
Lutherans.  His  endeavour  was  to  unite 
the  Eoman,  Lutheran,  and  Calvinistic 
Churches  in  the  bonds  of  charity  and 
mutual  forbearance,  under  the  idea  that,  as 
there  was  tiuth  in  the  three  communions, 
they  should  not  keep  apart.  He  affirmed 
that  the  Apostles'  Creed,  together  with  the 
light  thrown  upon  the  exegesis  of  Scripture 
by  the  early  Christian  writers,  was  a  suffi- 
cient bond  of  unity  amongst  Christians. 
Those  who  hold  such  liberal  ideas  have  also 
been  called  Syncretists. — Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  iii.  312, 317,  321-323 ;  Broughton, 
Bihlio,  vol.  i. ;  Bluut's  Sects,  p.  585. 


CALOYEES 

CALL  TO  THE  MIN  IhTRY.  There  are 
two  sorts  of  calls  to  the  ministry.  (1)  First 
the  outward ;  whereby  those  who  are  ap- 
pointed to  recommend  a  person  to  the 
execution  of  any  ecclesiastical  office,  fix 
upon  him,  as  one  in  their  judgment  quali- 
fied for  it;  and,  having  examined  him, 
present  him  to  the  bishop.  The  arch- 
deacon, or,  in  his  absence,  one  appointed  in 
his  stead,  presents  the  candidate;  and  the 
bishop,  approving  the  judgment,  admits 
him  into  such  oflice  in  due  manner,  as  the 
laws  of  God,  and  the  rites  of  the  Church 
require.  But  (2)  the  inward  call  is  some- 
thing preceding  this,  and  required  by  our 
Church  as  a  qualification  for  the  outward 
call. 

The  candidate  for  holy  orders  has  the 
question  of  the  inward  call  put  to  him 
thus :  Do  you  trust  that  you  are  inwardly 
moved  by  the  Holy  Ghost  to  take  upon 
you  this  office  and  ministration  to  serve 
God,  in  promoting  his  glory,  and  the  edi- 
fying of  his  people  ? 

"  This  is  a  great  question  indeed,  and 
that  which  no  man  can  give  a  true  and 
positive  answer  to,  without  having  searched 
narrowly  into  his  own  heart,  and  seriously 
considered  the  bent  and  inclinations  of  his 
soul.  But  it  is  a  question  very  necessary 
to  be  propounded,  for  the  Holy  Ghost  now 
supplies  the  place  and  room  of  our  blessed 
Saviour  in  his  Church  militant  here  on 
earth.  And  therefore  the  bishop  requires 
the  candidates  to  deal  plainly  and  faithfully 
with  him  and  the  Church,  and  to  tell  him 
whether  they  really  trust  that  they  are 
moved  by  the  Holy  Ghost  to  take  this 
office  upon  them?  To  which  every  one  is 
bound  to  answer,  '  I  trust  so ; '  not  that  he 
knows  it,  or  is  cer  ;ain  of  it,  for  it  is  possible 
that  his  heart  may  deceive  him  in  it,  but 
that  he  trusts  or  hopes  it  is  so." — Bp. 
Beveridge. 

Calvin's  definition  of  the  "inward  call" 
in  his  book  of  Institutes,  which  was  pub- 
lished about  ten  years  before  the  Ordinal  of 
Edward  VI.,  might  probably  have  been 
a  guide  to  our  Reformers  in  framing  this 
question.  It  wa.s,  "  That  it  is  the  good  testi- 
mony of  our  own  heart,  that  we  have  taken; 
this  office,  neither  for  ambition,  covetousness, 
nor  any  evil  design,  but  out  of  a  true  fear 
of  God,  and  a  desire  to  edify  the  Church." 

CAL(.)YERS.  A  general  name  given  to 
the  monks  of  the  Greek  Church.  It  is  taken 
from  the  Greek  KoKoytpaioi,  which  signifies. 
"  good  old  men."  (Helyot,  Hist,  des  Ord. 
Relig.  i.  cap.  19.)  'I  hese  "religious"  con- 
sider St.  Basil  as  their  father  and  founder, 
and  look  upon  it  as  a  crime  to  follow  any 
other  rule  than  his.  There  are  three  de- 
grees among  them  ;  the  novices,  who  are 
called    Archari ;     the     ordinary    professed,. 


CALVINISTIC 

called  Microcliemi ;  and  the  more  perfect, 
called  Megalochemi.  They  are  likewise 
divided  into  CcBnobites,  Anchorets,  and 
Becluses . 

The  most  considerable  monastery  of 
the  Greek  Caloyers  in  Asia  is  that  of 
Mount  Sinai,  which  was  founded  by  the 
emperor  Justinian.  They  have  a  great 
number  of  monasteries  in  Europe;  among 
■which  that  of  Penteli,  a  mountain  of  Attica, 
near  Athens,  is  remarkable  for  its  beauti- 
ful situation,  and  a  very  good  library. 

But  the  most  celebrated  monasteries  of 
Greek  Caloyers  are  those  of  Mount  Athos 
in  Macedonia.  They  are  twenty-three  in 
number ;  and  the  "religious  "  live  in  them  so 
regularly  that  the  Turks  themselves  have 
a  great  esteem  for  them,  and  often  recom- 
mend themselves  to  their  prayers.  Every- 
thing in  them  is  magnificent;  and,  not- 
withstanding they  have  been  under  the 
Turk  for  so  long  a  time,  they  have  lost 
nothing  of  their  grandeur. 

The  Caloyers  of  Mount  Athos  have  a 
great  aversion  to  the  pope,  and  relate  that  a 
Koman  pontiff,  having  visited  their  mona- 
steries, had  plundered  and  burned  some  of 
them,  because  they  would  not  adore  him. 

There  are  female  Caloyers,  or  Greek  nuns, 
who  likewise  follow  the  rule  of  St.  Basil. 
Their  nunneries  are  always  dependent  on 
some  monastery.  The  Turks  buy  sashes 
of  their  working,  and  they  open  their  gates 
freely  to  the  Turks  on  this  occasion. 
Those  of  Constantinople  are  widows,  some 
of  whom  have  had  several  husbands.  They 
make  no  vow,  nor  confine  themselves  within 
their  convents.  The  priests  are  forbidden, 
under  severe  penalties,  to  visit  these  re- 
ligious.— ^Broughton,  Biblio.  vol.  i. 

CALVINISTIC  METHODISTS.  (See 
Calvinists.) 

CALVINISTS.  Those  who  interpret 
Scripture  in  accordance  with  the  views  of 
John  Calvin,  who  was  born  at  Noyon, 
A.D.  1509,  and  afterwards  settled  at  Geneva, 
and  who  established  a  system  both  of  doc- 
trine and  of  discipline  peculiarly  his  own. 

I.  The  influence  of  Calvin's  ideas  and 
works  was  felt  in  England  from  the  time 
when  the  "  Lytell  Treatyse  of  ye  soper  of 
the  Lorde  made  by  Callwyu"  was  pub- 
lished and  prohibited  in  1542  (Burnet's 
Eist.  Reform.,  vol.  i.,  ii.  390).  He  did  not 
accept  an  invitation  from  Cranmer  to 
attend  a  conference  at  Lambeth,  but  he 
was  constantly  writing  to  the  Protector 
Somerset,  to  Cranmer,  and  to  Edward  VL, 
and  in  these  letters  he  delighted.  He  says 
that  Cranmer  himself  urged  him  to  write 
often  to  the  king, "  which  affords  me  greater 
delight  than  if  I  had  received  a  large  present 
of  money."  (Gorham's  Reform,  Gleanings, 
267.     See  also   Burnet,  vol.   ii.   180  seq.) 


CALVINISTS 


117 


He  condemned  the  Eeformation  of  the 
Church  of  England,  as  it  was  being  carried 
out,  and  there  can  be  no  doubt  that  his 
influence  over  Somerset,  Bucer,  and  Peter 
Martyr  had  a  great  deal  to  do  with  the 
alterations  made  in  the  Prayer  Book  of 
1552.  With  Elizabeth  he  gained  no  favour, 
the  queen  declining  to  accept  his  "Com- 
mentary on  Isaiah"  in  such  forcible  lan- 
guage, that  he  wrote  a  remonstrance  to  Sir 
William  Cecil.  {Zurich  Letters,  ii.  34.)  But 
the  Marian  persecution  had  done  its  work  ; 
and  numbers  returned  to  England  imbued 
with  the  Genevan  or  Calvinistic  doctrines. 
The  most  powerful  among  these  was  probably 
John  Knox,  but  many  other  eminent  men 
were  also  greatly  infected  by  Calvin's  ideas. 
So  much  so  that  Hooker  writes,  in  1549, 
"  his  books  were  almost  the  very  canon  to 
judge  both  doctrine  and  discipline  by." — 
Ecc.  Pol.,  Pref.  ii.  8. 

The  Calvinist  Directory  was  written  in 
French,  and  afterwards  published  in  Latin 
in  1545.  It  was  published  in  England,  in 
1551,  for  the  Strasburg  refugees,  who  had 
settled  at  Glastonbury,  by  PoUanus  (Pul- 
lain),  their  pastor. 

Most  of  the  modem  Dissenters  hold  in  a 
greater  or  less  degree  the  doctrines  of  Cal- 
vin, but  the  name  Calvinists,  or  Calvinistic 
Methodists,  is  generally  given  to  those  who 
followed  the  ideas  of  Whitfield  rather  than 
those  of  John  Wesley,  who  was  an  opponent 
of  Calvinism  at  the  end  of  the  last  century. 
They  have  adopted  now  the  title  of  "  In- 
dependent Methodists,"  and  follow  the  usages 
of  the  Independents.  But  there  is  a  large 
community  in  Wales,  which  still  retain  the 
old  name,  "  Welsh  Calvinists,"  or  "  Cal- 
vinistic Methodists."  These  number  about 
60,000,  with  over  200  ministers. 

II.  The  essential  doctrines  of  Calvinism 
have  been  reduced  to  these  five :  particular 
election,  particular  redemption,  moral  in- 
ability in  a  fallen  state,  irresistible  grace, 
and  the  final  perseverance  of  the  saints. 
These  are  termed,  by  theologians,  the  five 
points ;  and  ever  since  the  synod  of  Dort 
(see  Dort),  when  they  were  the  subjects  of 
discussion  between  the  Calvinists  and 
Arminians,  and  decrees  were  made  which 
are  the  standard  of  modern  Calvinism, 
many  controversies  have  "been  agitated  re- 
specting them.  Even  the  Calvinists  them- 
selves differ  in  the  explication  of  them ;  it 
cannot  therefore  be  ■  expected  that  a  very 
specific  account  of  them  should  be  given 
here.  Generally  speaking,  however,  they 
comprehend  the  following  propositions : — 

1st,    That    God    has    chosen    a    certain 
number  in  Christ  to  everlasting  glory,  be- 
fore the  foundation  of  the  world,  according 
to  his  immutable  purpose,  and  of  his  free 
I  grace  and  love,  without  the  least  foresight 


118 


CAMALDOLITES 


of  faith,  good  works,  or  any  conditions  per- 
formed by  the  creature;  and  that  the  rest 
of  mankind  he  was  pleased  to  pass  by,  and 
ordain  them  to  dishonour  and  wrath  for 
their  sins,  to  the  praise  of  his  vindictive 
justice. 

2nd]y,  That  Jesus  Christ,  by  his  suf- 
ferings and  death,  made  an  atonement  only 
for  the  sins  of  the  elect. 

3dly,  That  mankind  are  totally  depraved 
in  consequence  of  the  fall;  and,  by  virtue 
of  Adam's  being  their  public  head,  the 
guilt  of  his  sin  was  imputed,  and  a  corrupt 
nature  conveyed  to  all  his  posterity,  from 
which  proceeds  all  actual  transgression;  and 
that  by  sin  we  arc  made  subject  to  death, 
and  all  miseries,  temporal,  spiritual,  and 
eternal. 

4thly,  That  all  whom  God  has  predesti- 
nated to  life,  he  is  pleased,  in  his  appointed 
time,  effectually  to  call,  by  his  word  and 
Spirit,  out  of  that  state  of  sin  and  death,  in 
which  they  are  by  nature,  to  grace  and 
salvation  by  Jesus  Christ. 

And  5thly,  That  those  whom  God  has 
effectually  called  and  sanctified  by  his 
Spirit,  shall  never  finally  fall  from  a  state 
of  grace. 

CAMALDOLITES,  or  CAMALDULEN- 
SIANS.  A  religious  order  of  Christians 
founded  by  Romuald,  an  Italian  of  noble 
birth,  at  the  beginning  of  the  eleventh 
century  (a.d.  1023).  Those  who  belong  to 
it  are  divided  into  Cauobites,  and  Eremites, 
and  foUow  the  rule  of  St.  Benedict.  The 
first  monastery  was  built  at  Camaldoli,  or 
Campo-Malduli,  on  the  Apennines.  The 
order  was  approved  by  Pope  Alexander  II. ; 
and  its  constitutions  were  drawn  up  by 
Eodolphus,  fourth  General,  in  1102.  The 
congregation  of  hermits  of  St.  Eomuald,  or 
of  Mount  Couronne,  is  a  branch  of  the 
Camaldoli,  to  which  it  was  joined  in  1532. 
Paul  Justinian,  of  Venice,  began  its  estab- 
lishment in  1520,  and  founded  the  chief 
monastery  in  the  Ajjennines,  in  a  place 
called  the  Mount  of  the  Crown,  ten  miles 
from  Perugia,  and  dedicated  to  our  Saviour 
in  1555.  Besides  these  there  are  the  con- 
gregations of  St.  Michael  de  Murano,  of 
Turin  and  of  France. — Helyot's  Eist  des 
Ord.  vol.  i.  p.  236 ;  Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim, 
ii.  43. 

CAMERONIANS.  A  party  of  Presby- 
terians in  Scotland,  so  called  from  Richard 
Cameron,  a  field  preacher,  the  first  who 
separated  from  communion  with  the  other 
Presbyterians,  who  acquiesced  in  the 
indulgences  granted  to  the  ministers  by 
Charles  II.  in  1669  and  1672.  They  were 
also  called  Cargillites,  from  Donald  Cargill, 
another  field  preacher.  They  considered 
the  acceptance  of  the  indulgence  to  be  a 
countenancing  of  the  supremacy  in  ecclesi- 


CAMISAEDS 

astical  affairs.  The  other  Presbyterian.? 
wished  the  controversy  to  drop,  till  it  could 
be  determined  by  a  general  assembly;  but 
the  Cameronians,  through  a  transport  of 
zeal,  separated  from  them,  and  some  who 
associated  with  them  ran  into  excess  of 
frenzy;  declarmg  that  King  Charles  II.  had 
forfeited  his  rifiht  to  the  crown  and  society 
of  the  Church,  by  his  breaking  the  solemn 
league  and  covenant,  and  by  his  vicious  life, 
they  pretended  both  to  dethrone  and  ex- 
communicate him,  and  for  that  purpose 
made  an  insurrection,  but  were  soon  sup- 
pressed. After  the  accession  of  King  Wil- 
liam III.  to  the  crown,  they  complied  with 
and  zealously  served  the  government;  and 
as  regarded  their  former  diflerences  in  Church 
matters,  they  were  also  laid  aside,  the 
preachers  of  their  party  having  submitted 
to  the  General  Assembly  of  the  Scottish 
establishment  in  1690.  The  party,  however, 
still  exists.  In  1743  John  Macmillan,  who 
had  been  expelled  from  the  Kirk  in  1703, 
gathered  together  a  considerable  number  of 
persons  who,  under  the  name  of  "  Reformed 
Presbyterians,"  claimed  to  be  the  represen- 
tatives of  the  old  Cameronians  or  Cove- 
nanters. In  1860  the  bath  of  allegiance 
had  by  them  to  be  considered  (in  conse- 
quence of  the  volunteer  movement),  and 
at  the  same  time  came  up  the  question  of 
the  use  of  the  franchise  in  elections  for 
Parliament.  Both  had  been  forbidden  by 
the  society,  but  in  1863  their  synod  enacted 
"  that  while  recommending  the  members  of 
the  Church  to  abstain  from  the  use  of  the 
franchise,  and  from  taking  the  oath  of  allegi- 
ance ;  discipline  to  the  effect  of  suspension 
and  expulsion  from  the  Church  shall  cease." 
This  did  not  meet  with  the  general  assent  of 
the  party,  and  at  the  present  time  there  are 
two  distinct  bodies  in  Scotland  under  the 
same  name.  In  America,  and  in  Ireland, 
there  are  branches  of  this  sect,  which 
represent  the  Cameronians  under  the  name 
of  Reformed  Presbyterians. — Lingard,  xii. 
294  seq. ;  Lawson's  Sp.  Oh.  Scot.  c.  xi. ; 
Hetherington's  Eist.  of  Ch.  of  Scot. ;  Blunt's 
Diet,  of  Sects,  p.  98. 

CAMERONITES.  A  sect  of  French 
Protestants,  who  derived  their  name  from 
John  Cameron,  of  Glasgow,  professor  of 
Theology  at  Saumur,  about  1610.  He 
endeavoured  to  reconcile  the  Calvinist  and 
Catholic  doctrines  with  regard  to  the  Divine 
decrees ;  asserting  that  God  wills  the  salva- 
tion of  all  men,  and  not  only  of  the  elect 
few :  that  none  are  excluded  from  Divine 
favour  who  make  their  choice  aright 
between  good  and  evil.  But  his  semi- 
Calvinism  was  condemned  at  the  Council  of 
Dort  (1618).  His  works  were  printed  at 
Geneva  in  a  folio  volume  in  1658. 

CAMISARDS.      The    popular    name   of 


CANCELLl 

the  Protestants  who  rose  in  the  Cevennes 
against  the  oppression  of  Louis  XIV.  of 
France,  after  the  revocation  of  the  edict  of 
Nantes  in  1685.  There  are  various  etymo- 
logies of  the  word ;  the  most  probable  is 
that  which  derives  it  from  camisa  or  chemise, 
in  allusion  to  the  House  or  smock-frock 
which  was  generally  worn. 
CANCELLl.  (See  Chancel.) 
CANDLES.  (See  Lights  on  the  Altar.) 
CANDLEMAS  DAY.  A  name  formerly 
given  to  the  festival  of  the  Purification  of 
the  Virgin  Mary,  observed  in  our  Church, 
February  2.  In  the  mediseval  church,  this 
day  was  remarkable  for  the  number  of 
lighted  candles  which  were  borne  about  in 
processions,  and  placed  in  churches,  in 
memory  of  Him  who,  in  the  words  of 
Simeon's  song  at  the  Purification,  came  to 
be  "  a  light  to  lighten  the  Gentiles,  and  the 
glory  of  his  people  Israel."  From  this 
custom  the  name  is  supposed  to  be  derived. 
It  was  usual  for  women  to  bear  candles 
when  they  were  churched.  (See  Lingard,  ii. 
65.)  These  candles  were  solemnly  blessed 
according  to  a  form  given  by  Hospinian. — 
Brand's  Antiq.  p.  220. 

CANON.  The  laws  of  the  Church  are 
called  canons,  the  word  canon  being  derived 
from  a  Greek  word,  which  signifies  a  rule  or 
measure. 

Since  the  Church  is  a  society  of  Christians, 
and  since  every  society  must  have  authority 
to  prescribe  rules  and  laws  for  the  govern- 
ment of  its  own  members,  it  must  neces- 
sarily follow  that  the  Church  should  have 
this  power;  for  otherwise  there  would  be 
great  disorder  amongst  Christians.  This 
power  was  exercised  in  the  Church  before 
the  Roman  empire  became  Christian,  as 
appears  by  those  ancient  canons  which  were 
made  before  that  time,  and  which  are  men- 
tioned in  the  writings  of  the  primitive 
fathers;  by  the  apostolical  canons,  which, 
though  not  made  by  the  apostles  themselves, 
are  nevertheless  of  considerable  antiquity ; 
and  by  various  canons  which  were  made  in 
councils  held  in  the  second  century,  which 
were  binding,  and  to  be  observed  by  the 
clergy,  under  the  penalty  of  deprivation; 
and  by  the  laity,  under  pain  of  excommuni- 
cation. Under  this  title  we  wiU  mention : 
1.  Foreign  canons.  2.  Such  as  have  been 
received  here.  3.  The  power  of  making 
new  canons. 

I.  As  to  the  first,  Constantine  the 
Great,  the  first  emperor  who  gave  Christians 
some  respite  from  persecution,  caused 
general  councils  and  national  and  provincial 
synods  to  be  assembled  in  his  dominions ; 
where,  amongst  other  things,  rules  were 
made  for  the  government  of  the  Church, 
■vyhich  were  called  canons ;  the  substance 
of  which  was  at  first  collected  out  of  the 


CANON 


119 


Scriptures,  or  the  ancient  writings  of  the 
fathers.  It  is  not  necessary  to  give  a  long 
history  of  provincial  constitutions,  synodals, 
glossaries,  sentences  of  popes,  summaries, 
and  rescripts,  from  which  the  canon  law 
has,  by  degrees,  been  compiled,  since  the 
days  of  that  emperor;  it  is  sufficient  to 
state,  that  they  were  collected  by  Ivo, 
bishop  of  Chartres,  about  the  14th  year 
of  our  King  Henry  L,  in  three  volumes, 
which  are  commonly  called  the  Decrees. 
These  decrees,  corrected  by  Gratian,  a  Bene- 
dictine monk,  were  published  in  England  in 
the  reign  of  King  Stephen ;  and  the  reason 
of  the  publication  at  that  time  might  be  to 
decide  the  quarrel  between  Theobald,  arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  and  Henry,  bishop  of 
Winchester,  the  king's  brother,  the  appoint- 
ment of  whom  to  the  office  of  legate,  the 
archbishop  looked  upon  as  a  diminution  of 
his  own  power,  and  an  encroachment  upon 
that  privilege  which  he  had  as  legatus  natus. 
(See  Legate.)  These  decrees  were  received 
by  the  clergy  of  the  Western  Church,  but 
never  by  those  of  the  East,  which  is  one 
reason  why  their  priests  continued  to  marry, 
which  the  clergy  of  the  West  were,  by  these 
decrees  forbidden  to  do. 

The  next,  in  order  of  time,  were  the 
Decretals  (see  Decretals),  which  are  canoni- 
cal epistles  written  by  popes  alone,  or 
assisted  by  some  cardinals,  to  determine  any 
controversy ;  and  of  these  there  are  likewise 
three  volumes.  The  first  volume  of  these 
Decretals  was  compiled  by  Eaimundus 
Barcinus,  who  was  chaplain  to  Gregory  IX., 
and  were  published  by  him  about  the  14  th 
year  of  King  Hemy  III.,  a.d.  1226.  This 
was  appointed  to  be  read  in  all  schools,  and 
was  to  be  taken  for  law  in  all  ecclesiastical 
courts.  About  sixty  years  afterwards, 
Simon,  a  monk  of  Walden,  began  to  read 
these  laws  in  the  university  of  Cambridge, 
and  the  next  year  in  Oxford.  The  second 
volume  was  collected  and  arranged  by 
Boniface  VIII.,  and  published  about  the 
27th  year  of  our  King  Edward  L,  a.d.  1298. 
The  third  volume  was  collected  by  Clement 
v.,  and  pubhshed  in  the  Council  of  Vienne, 
and  likewise  here,  in  the  2nd  year  of 
Edward  II.,  a.d.  1308,  and  from  the  name 
of  the  pope  were  called  Clementines. 

These  decretals  were  never  received  in 
England,  or  anywhere  else,  except  in  the 
pope's  dominions,  and  are  therefore  called 
by  canonists  Patriae  ohedientise,  as  particu- 
larly the  canon  concerning  the  investiture 
of  bishops  by  a  lay  hand.  John  Andreas, 
a  celebrated  canonist  in  the  fourteenth  cen- 
tury, wrote  a  commentary  on  these  de- 
cretals, which  he  entitled  Novelise,  from  a 
very  beautiful  daughter  he  had  of  that 
name,  whom  he  bred  a  scholar:  the  father 
being  a  professor  of  law  at  Bologna,  had 


120 


CANON 


instructed  his  daughter  so  well  in  it,  that 
she  assisted  him  in  reading  lectures  to  his 
scholars,  and,  therefore,  to  perpetuate  her 
memory,  he  gave  that  book  the  title  of 
Novellie. 

About  the  tenth  year  of  King  Edward 
II.,  John  XXII.  published  his  Eatrava- 
gants.  But  as  to  the  Church  of  England, 
even  at  that  time,  when  the  papal  authority 
was  at  ihe  highest,  none  of  these  foreign 
canons,  or  any  new  canons,  made  at  any 
national  or  provincial  synod  here,  had  any 
manner  of  force  if  they  were  against  the 
prerogative  of  the  king,  or  the  laws  of  the 
land.  It  is  true  that  every  Christian  nation 
in  communion  with  the  pope  sent  some 
bishops,  abbots,  or  priors,  to  those  foreign 
councils,  and  generally  four  were  sent  out 
of  England ;  and  it  was  by  those  means, 
together  with  the  allowance  of  the  civil 
power,  that  some  canons  made  there  were 
received  here,  but  such  as  were  against  the 
laws  were  totally  rejected. 

Nevertheless,  some  of  these  foreign  canons 
were  received  in  England,  and  obtained  the 
force  of  laws  by  the  general  approbation  of 
the  king  and  people  (though  it  is  difBoult 
to  know  wliat  these  canons  are),  as  there  was 
never  any  authoritative  collection  of  them ; 
and  it  was  upon  this  pretence  that  the  pope 
claimed  an  ecclesiastical  jurisdiction,  inde- 
pendent of  the  king,  and  sent  his  legates  to 
England  with  commissions  to  determine 
causes  according  to  those  •  canons,  which 
were  now  compiled  into  several  volumes, 
and  called  Jus  Oanonicum :  these  were  not 
only  enjoined  to  be  obeyed  as  laws,  but 
publicly  to  be  read  and  expounded  in  all 
schools  and  universities  as  the  civil  law  was 
read  and  expounded  there,  under  pain  of 
excommunication  to  those  who  neglected. 
Hence  arose  quarrels  between  kings  and 
several  archbishops  and  other  prelates,  who 
adhered  to  those  papal  usurpations. 

II.  Besides  these  foreign  canons,  there 
were  several  laws  and  constitutions  made 
here  for  the  government  of  the  Church,  all 
of  which  are  now  in  force,  but  which  had 
not  been  so  without  the  assent  and  confirm- 
ation of  the  kings  of  England.  Even  from 
William  I.  to  the  time  of  the  Reformation, 
no  canons  or  constitutions  made  in  any 
synods  were  suffered  to  be  executed  if  they 
had  not  the  royal  assent.  This  was  the 
common  usage  and  practice  in  England, 
even  when  the  papal  usurpation  was  most 
exalted ;  for  if  at  any  time  the  ecclesiastical 
courts  did,  by  their  sentences,  endeavour  to 
force  obedience  to  such  canons,  the  courts 
at  common  law,  upon  complaint  made, 
would  grant  prohibitions.  So  that  the 
statute  of  submission,  which  was  afterwards 
made  in  the  twenty-fifth  year  of  Henry  VIII., 
seems  to  bo  declarative  of  the  common  law. 


CANON 

that  the  clergy  could  not  de  jure,  and  by 
their  own  authority,  v^ithout  the  king's 
assent,  enact  or  execute  any  canons.  These 
canons  were  all  collected  and  explained  by 
Lyndwood,  Dean  of  the  Arches,  in  the  reign 
of  Henry  VI.,  and  by  him  reduced  under 
this  method.  But  it  is  not  to  be  supposed 
that  these  are  valid  as  the  law  of  England. 
They  are  a  mere  historical  collection.  There 
is  in  fact  no  such  thing  as  a  canon  law  of 
England.  There  are  the  canons  lawfully 
made  and  ratified,  and  there  is  the  "  King's 
ecclesiastical  law,"  as  it  has  often  beeu 
called  by  the  judges,  and  no  more. 

1.  The  canons  of  Stephen  Langton,  arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  made  at  a  council 
held  at  Oxford,  in  the  sixth  year  of  Henry 
III. 

2.  The  canons  of  Otho,  the  pope's  legate, 
who  held  a  council  in  St.  Paul's  church,  in 
the  twenty-fifth  year  of  Henry  III.,  which 
from  him  were  called  the  Constitutions  of 
Otho;  upon  which  John  de  Athon,  one  of 
the  canons  of  Lincoln,  wrote  a  comment. 

3.  The  canons  of  Boniface,  of  Savoy, 
archbishop  of  Canterbury,  in  the  forty-fifth 
of  Henry  III.,  which  were  all  usurpations 
upon  the  common  law,  as  concerning  the 
boundaries  of  parishes,  the  right  of  patron- 
age, and  against  trials  of  the  right  of  tithes 
in  the  king's  courts  against  writs  of  pro- 
hibition, &c.  Although  he  threatened  the 
judges  with  excommunication  (some  of  the 
judges  being  at  that  time  clergymen)  if 
they  disobeyed  the  canons,  yet  they  pro- 
ceeded in  these  matters  according  to  the 
laws  of  the  realm,  and  kept  the  ecclesiastical 
courts  within  their  proper  jurisdiction. 
This  occasioned  a  variance  between  the 
spiritual  and  temporal  lords ;  and  upon  this 
the  clergy,  in  the  thirty-first  of  Henry  III., 
exhibited  several  articles  of  their  grievances 
to  the  parliament,  which  they  called  Ar- 
ticuli  Cleri :  the  articles  themselves  are  lost, 
but  some  of  the  answers  to  them  are  extant, 
by  which  it  appears  that  none  of  these 
canons  made  by  Boniface  was  confirmed. 

4.  The  canons  of  Cardinal  Ottobon,  the 
pope's  legate,  who  held  a  synod  at  St.  Paul's, 
in  the  fifty-third  of  Henry  III.,  in  which  he 
confirmed  those  canons  made  by  his  pre- 
decessor Otho,  and  published  some  new  ones ; 
and  by  his  legatine  authority  commanded 
that  they  should  be  obeyed:  upon  these 
canons,  likewise,  John  de  Athon  wrote 
another  comment. 

5.  The  canons  of  Archbishop  Peckham, 
made  at  a  synod  held  at  Reading,  in  the 
year  1279,  the  seventh  of  Edward  I. 

6.  The  canons  of  the  same  archbishop, 
made  at  a  synod  held  at  Lambeth,  two  years 
afterwards. 

7.  The  canons  of  Archbishop  Winchelsea, 
made  in  the  thirty-fourth  of  Edward  I. 


CANON 

8.  The  canons  of  Archbishop  Reynolds, 
at  a  synod  held  at  Oxford,  in  the  year  1322, 
the  sixteenth  of  Edward  II. 

9.  The  canons  of  Symon  Mepham,  arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  made  in  the  year 
1328,  the  third  of  Edward  III. 

10.  Of  Archbishop  Stratford. 

11.  Of  Archbishop  Simon  Islip,  made 
1362,  the  thirty-seventh  of  Edward  III. 

12.  Of  Symon  Sudbury,  archbishop  of 
Canterbury,  made  in  the  year  1378,  the 
second  of  Richard  II. 

13.  Of  Archbishop  Arundel,  made  at  a 
synod  at  Oxford,  in  the  year  1403,  the  tenth 
of  Henry  IV. 

14.  Of  Archbishop  Chichely,  in  the  year 
1415,  the  third  of  Henry  V. 

15.  Of  Edmond  and  Richard,  archbishops 
of  Canterbury,  who  immediately  succeeded 
Stephen  Langton. 

It  was  intended  to  reform  these  canons 
soon  after  the  Reformation ;  and  Archbishop 
Cranmer  and  some  other  commissioners  were 
appointed  for  that  purpose  by  Henry  VIII. 
and  Edward  VI.  under  the  authority  of  Acts 
of  Parliament.  The  work  was  finished, 
but  the  king  dying  before  it  was  confirmed, 
it  remains  unconfirmed  to  this  day.  The 
book  is  called  "Reformatio  Legum  Eccles- 
iasticarum  ex  Authoritate  Regis  Henry  VIII. 
inchoata  et  per  Edward  VI.  provecta:"  it 
was  put  into  elegant  Latin  by  Dr.  Haddon, 
who  was  then  university  orator  of  Cam- 
bridge, assisted  by  Sir  John  Cheke,  who 
was  tutor  to  Edward  VI. 

III.  The  next  thing  to  be  considered 
is,  the  authority  for  making  canons  since  the 
statute  25  Henry  VIII.  c.  19,  commonly 
called  the  Act  of  submission  of  the  clergy, 
which  was  founded  upon  "  The  submission  of 
the  clergy "  in  their  convocations  the  year 
before,  16th  May,  1532.  Thereby  they  did 
"  offer  arid  promise  in  verto  sacerdotii  imto 
your  highness  that  we  will  never  from 
henceforth  presume  to  attempt  allege  claim 
put  in  use,  or  enact,  promulge  or  execute 
[the  words  of  diff'erent  copies  vary  slightly 
and  immaterially]  any  new  canons  or  con- 
stitutions or  any  other  new  ordinance, 
provincial  or  synodal,  in  our  convocations  in 
time  coming  ;  which  convocation  is,  always 
hath  been,  and  must  be  assembled  only  by 
your  high  commandment  of  writ  [and] 
unless  only  your  highness  shall  license  us  to 
assemble  our  convocations  and  to  make 
promulge  and  execute  the  same,  and  then  to 
give  your  royal  assent  and  authority. 
Secondly,  that  whereas  diverse  constitutions 
and  canons  provincial  which  have  been 
heretofore  enacted  be  thoiight  not  only 
much  prejudicial  to  your  prerogative  royal 
but  also  over-much  onerous  to  your  high- 
nesses subjects  your  clergy  aforesaid  is  con- 
tented, if  it  may  stand  so  with  your  high- 


CANON 


121 


nesses  pleasure,  that  it  may  be  committed 
to  the  examination  and  judgment  of  your 
grace  and  of  thirty-two  persons,  whereof 
sixteen  to  be  of  the  upper  and  nether  house 
of  the  temporalty,  and  other  sixteen  of  the 
clergy  to  be  appdinted  by  your  highness,  so 
that  finally  whichsoever  of  the  said  constitu- 
tions, &c.,  shall  be  thought  and  determined 
by  your  grace,  and  by  the  most  part  of  the 
said  thirty-two  persons,  annulled  [or]  not  to 
stand  with  God's  laws  and  the  laws  of  your 
realm,  the  same  to  be  abrogated  and  taken 
away,"  but  (in  short)  all  others  to  stand. 

The  Act  substantially  followed  the  words 
of  the  submission,  reciting  it,  and  authorised 
the  appointment  of  the  thirty-two  com- 
missioners, of  whom  it  is  a  striking  fact 
with  reference  to  present  discussions  that 
half  was  to  be  laymen,  and  the  clergy  to  be 
appointed  by  the  Crown.  Somehow  or 
other  .neither  that  commission  nor  the 
similar  one  authorised  and  appointed  under 
Edward  VI.  ever  completed  their  work  so 
far  as  to  obtain  the  final  royal  sanction  of 
the  Reformatio  Legum  as  just  now  men- 
tioned. That  Act  of  25  Henry  VIIL  did 
more,  which  is  not  material  to  this  question 
of  canons,  for  it  prohibited  all  appeals  to 
Rome,  and  substituted  the  appeal  to  "  Dele- 
gates" to  be  appointed  by  the  king  in 
Chancery  (see  Delegates);  and  with  all  that 
part  of  the  Act  the  convocations  had  nothing 
to  do,  and  never  have  had  with  any  legislation 
about  jurisdiction  or  ecclesiastical  courts. 
The  result  has  always  been  acknowledged 
to  be  that  the  convocations  cannot  lawfully 
meet  without  the  king's  writ,  and  cannot 
even  discuss  any  question  of  canons  without 
special  licence  therefor,  nor  afterwards 
"  promulge  "  any  new  canon  without  ratifi- 
cation under  the  Great  Seal ;  and  that  course 
was  followed  in  the  only  modern  instance  of 
a  new  canon,  viz.,  the  alteration  of  the 
thirty-sixth,  though  it  was  only  to  follow 
an  Act  of  Parliament,  altering  the  terms  of 
clerical  subscription  in  1866.  In  another 
case  ratification  under  the  Great  Seal  was 
finally  refused,  even  though  the  royal  licence 
to  deal  with  the  canon  (29)  had  been  given 
beforehand. 

No  new  canons  were  made  mider  Henry 
VIII.  or  Edward  VI.  Some  were  made  in 
1571  under  Elizabeth,  recognising  her  Ad- 
vertisements of  1565,  (q.  v.),  but  they  were 
never  ratified  by  her ;  but  the  present  ones 
of  1603  are  much  the  same  in  effect.  Again, 
there  were  some  canons  made  under  and 
ratified  by  Charles  I.  in  1640,  but  immedi- 
ately voted  null  and  void  by  the  Long 
Parliament,  and  many  of  them  were  so 
plainly  ultra  vires  of  any  convocation  as  to 
neutralise  the  whole,  besides  other  real  or 
alleged  defects  of  form ;  and  they  have 
never  been  contended  to  be  valid.     So  the 


122 


CANON 


only  valid  post-Reformation  canons  are 
those  of  1603-4.  And  it  is  now  impossible 
to  say,  except  from  general  legal  recognition, 
wliich  of  the  older  canons  really  were 
adopted  into  the  King's  Ecclesiastical  Law, 
or  were  even  treated  as  valid  here  at  all. 
The  old  ecclesiastical  law  is  in  that  respect 
like  the  old  common  law,  for  which  no 
statutable  authority  exists,  and  which  is 
only  known  from  legal  decisions  and  tradi- 
tions preserved  in  law  bonks. 

It  is  also  impossible  to  state  any  general 
rule  for  determining  the  legal  validity  of 
any  particular  canon  in  matters  affecting 
the  laity,  directly  or  indirectly.  It  has 
been  decided  whenever  they  have  come 
before  the  law  courts  that  they  never  do 
bind  the  laity  propria  vigore,  or  so  far  as 
they  were  new,  and  the  ecclesiastical  courts 
were  always  prohibited  when  necessary  from 
enforcing  them.  But  where  there  is  reason 
to  believe  that  they  were  only  an  affirmance 
of  the  old  ecclesiastical  law  of  the  realm, 
the  civil  courts  recognise  them.  For  in- 
stance, they  decided  lately  on  that  ground 
in  R.  V.  Allen  (L.  E.  8  Q.  B.  70)  that  the 
election  of  churchwardens  ought  to  be 
according  to  canon  89,  though  churchwardens 
are  not  solely  ecclesiastical  officers,  and  the 
civil  courts,  not  the  ecclesiastical,  accordingly 
try  the  validity  of  their  election  (see  Church- 
wardens). But  it  is  an  entire  mistake  to 
suppose  that  the  canons  are  binding  on  the 
laity  whenever  they  are  not  overridden  by 
Acts  of  Parliament.  It  is  quite  true  that  by 
the  Act  of  Henry  VIII.  they  become  as  valid 
and  as  widely  effective  as  canons  can  be, 
when  duly  ratified  under  the  Great  Seal. 
But  in  that  respect  they  are  only  analogous 
to  the  bye-laws  or  private  statutes  of  corpora- 
tions of  all  kinds,  whether  enforceable  by  the 
visitors  or  by  the  courts  of  law,  on  those 
who  were  before  legally  subject  to  that 
jurisdiction  and  to  such  bye-laws  as  the 
given  bodies  may  have  from  time  to  time.  It 
must'be  carefully  borne  in  mind  that  the 
Church  of  England  as  a  body  of  clergy  and 
laity  has  never  been  legally  held  to  be 
represented  by  the  two  convocations,  but 
quite  the  contrary.  It  has  been  well  ob- 
served, by  an  umnistakable  writer  of  clerical 
distinction,  in  the  Quarterly  Review  of 
July,  1885,  that  the  decree  of  the  very 
"  first  Christian  CouncU  "  (in  Acts  xv.)  was 
not  promulgated  without  the  concurrence  of 
the  "  brethren  "  as  well  as  the  "  Apostles  and 
Elders."  And  if  the  Beformatio  Legum 
had  been  passed,  the  canon  law  of  the 
Church  would  have  been  made  by  as  many 
laymen  as  clergymen.     [G.] 

It  may  be  as  well,  for  the  convenience  of 
students,  to  insert  here,  from  Bishop  Halifax's 
Analysis  of  the  Civil  Law,  a  few  explana- 
tions of  the  method  of  quoting  the   Jus 


CANON 

Canonicum.  The  Decretum  of  Gratian 
(which  must  not  be  confounded  with  the 
Decretals)  is  divided  into,  1.  Distinctions. 
2.  Causes.  3.  Treatise  concerning  consecra- 
tion. The  Decretals  are  divided  into,  1. 
Gregory  IX.  Decretals  in  5  hooks.  2.  The 
sixth  Decretal.  (Boniface.  1298.)  3.  The 
Clementine  Constitutions  (of  Pope  Clement 
v.).  Now  in  the  Decretum,  1st  part,  e.g. 
"  1  dist.  c.  3,  Lex,  [or  i.  d.  Lex,]  is  the  first 
distinction,  3rd  Canon,  beginning  with  the 
word  Lex.  In  the  Decretum,  2nd  part,  e.g. 
"  3  qu.  9,  c.  2,"  means  the  third  cause,  ninth 
question,  2nd  Canon.  The  3rd  part  of  the 
Decretum  is  quoted  as  the  first,  with  the 
addition  of  the  words  de  consecratione. 

In  the  Decretals  (the  first  division)  is 
given  the  name  of  title,  number  of  chapter, 
with  the  addition  of  extra,  or  a  capital  X. 
E.g.  "  c.  3,  extra  de  usuris,"  means  the  3rd 
chapter  of  Gregory's  Decretals  inscribed 
"  de  usuris,"  i.e.  the  19th  of  the  5th  book. 
"  c.  cum  contingat  36  X.  de  off.  et  Pot.  Jud. 
del.,"  means  the  36th  chapter  beginning 
with  "  cum  contingat,"  of  the  Title  in  Gre- 
gory's decrees,  inscribed  "  de  officio."  The 
sixth  Decretal,  and  the  Clementine  Consti- 
tutions, are  quoted  the  same  way,  except 
that  instead  of  extra,  or  X.,  is  subjoined  in 
sexto,  or  in  6 ;  and  in  Clementini,  or  in 
Clem.  The  Extravagants  of  John  XXII. 
are  contained  in  one  book,  xiv.  titles. 

The  following  are  the 

CANONS  OF  1603. 

Constitutions  and  Canons  Ecclesiastical, 
treated  upon  by  the  Bishop  of  London, 
President  of  the  Convocation  for  the  Pro- 
vince of  Canterbury,  and  the  rest  of  the 
Bishops  and  Clergy  of  the  said  Province ; 
and  agreed  upon  with  the  King's  Majesty's 
Licence,  in  their  Synod  begun  at  London, 
Anno  Domini  1603,  and  in  the  year  of  the 
Eeign  of  our  sovereign  Lord  James,  by  the 
Grace  of  God,  King  of  England,  Prance, 
and  Ireland,  the  First,  and  of  Scotland 
the  Thirty-seventh:  and  now  published 
for  the  due  observation  of  them,  by  his 
Majesty's  Authority  under  the  Great  Seal 
of  England. 

It  will  be  observed  that  this  does  not 
mention  the  Province  of  York.  But  the  same 
canons  were  afterwards,  on  10th  March, 
1604-5,  duly  voted  by  the  York  Convocation 
and  the  king's  assent  to  them  prayed.  And 
at  the  end  of  canons  as  usually  printed, 
there  is  another  ratification  expressly  for 
both  provinces;  but  it  is  undated,  and  it 
does  not  seem  to  be  now  demonstrable  that 
royal  ratification  was  again  given  after  the 
vote  of  the  York  Convocation.  But  on 
legal  principles  that  is  immaterial,  for  the 
presmuption  omnia  fuisse  rite  acta  is  amply 
sufficient  alter    such  long  and  undisputed 


usage  in  York  as  well  as  Canterbury.     (See 
Trevor  on  the  Two  Convocations.') 

Tlie  Tabic  of  the  Constitutions  and  Canons 

Ecclesiastical. 

Of  the  Church  of  England. 

1.  The  King's  Supremacy  over  the  Church 

of  England,  m  Causes  Ecclesiastical, 
to  be  maintained. 

2.  Impugners   of   tlie    King's   Supremacy 

censured. 

3.  The  Church   of    England  a  true   and 

apostolical  Church. 

4.  Impugners   of  the  public  Worship  of 

Godj  established  in  the  Church  of 
England,  censured. 

5.  Impugners  of  the  Articles  of  Religion, 

established  in  the  Church  of  England, 
censured. 

6.  Impugners  of  the  Rites  and  Ceremonies, 

established  in  the  Church  of  England, 
censured. 

7.  Impugners  of  the  Government  of  the 

Church  of  England,  by  Archbishops, 
Bishops,  &c.,  censured. 

8.  Impugners  of  the  Form  of  consecrating 

and  ordering  Archbishops,  Bishops, 
&c.  in  the  Church  of  England,  cen- 
sured. 

9.  Authors  of  Schism   in   the  Church  of 

England  censured. 

10.  Maintainers  of  Schismatics  in  the  Church 

of  England  censured. 

11.  Maintainers  of  Conventicles  censured. 

12.  Maintainers  of  Constitutions  made   in 

Conventicles  censured. 

Of  Divine  Service,  and  Administration  of 
the  Sacraments. 

13.  Due  Celebration  of  Sundays  and  Holy- 

days. 

14.  The  prescript  Form  of  Divine   Service 

to  be  used  on  Sundays  and  Holy-days. 

15.  The  Litany  to  be  read  on  Wednesdays 

and  Fridays. 

16.  Colleges  to  use  the  prescript  Form  of 

Divine  Service. 

17.  Students  in  Colleges  to  wear  Surplices 

in  time  of  Divine  Service. 

18.  A  reverence  and  attention  to  be  used 

■within  the  Church  in  time  of  Divine 
Service. 

19.  Loiterers  not   to  be   suffered  near  the 

Church  in  time  of  Divine  Service. 

20.  Bread  and  Wine  to  be  provided  against 

every  Communion. 

21.  The  Communion  to  be  thrice  a  Year 

received. 

22.  Warning  to  be  given  beforehand  for  the 

Communion. 

23.  Students    in   Colleges    to    receive    the 

Communion  four  times  a  Year. 

24.  Copes  to  be  worn  in  Cathedral  Churches 


CANON 


123 


by  those   that  administer   the  Com- 
munion. 

25.  Surplices  and    Hoods    to   be  worn  in 

Cathedral  Churches,  when  there  is  no 
Communion. 

26.  Notorious  Offenders  not  to  be  admitted 

to  the  Communion. 

27.  Schismatics  not  to  be  admitted  to  the 

Communion. 

28.  Strangers  not   to  be   admitted  to   the 

Communion. 

29.  Fathers  not  to  be  Godfathers  in  Bap- 

tism, and  Children  not  Communicants. 

30.  The  lawful  use  of  the  Cross  in  Baptism 

explained. 

Ministers,  their  Ordination,  Function,  and 
Charge. 

31.  Four   solemn  times  appointed  for   the 

making  of  Ministers. 

32.  None  to  be  made  Deacon  and  Minister 

both  in  one  day. 

33.  The  Titles  of  such  as  are  to  be  made 

Ministers. 

34.  The  Quality  of  such  as  are  to  be  made 

Ministers. 

35.  The  Examination  of  such  as  are  to  be 

made  Ministers. 

36.  Subscription  required  of  such  as  are  to 

be  made  Minister.^. 

The  Articles  of  Subscription. 
The  Form  of  Subscription. 

37.  Subscription  before  the  Diocesan. 

38.  Revolters  after  Subscription  censured. 

39.  Cautions  for  Institution  of  Ministers  into 

Benefices. 

40.  An  Oath  against  Simony  at  Institution 

into  Benefices. 

41.  Licences    for    Plurality    of    Benefices 

limited,  and  Residence  enjoined. 

42.  Residence  of  Deans  in  their  Churches. 

43.  Deans  and  Prebendaries  to  preach  during 

their  Residence. 

44.  Prebendaries  to  be  resident  upon  their 

Benefices. 

45.  Beneficed  Preachers,  being  resident  upon 

their   Livings,  to  preach  every  Sun- 
day. 

46.  Beneficed  Men,  not  Preachers,  to   pro- 

cure monthly  Sermons. 

47.  Absence  of  Beneficed  Men  to  be  supplied 

by  Curates  that  are  allowed  Preachers. 

48.  None  to  be  Curates  but  allowed  by  the 

Bishop. 

49.  Ministers,  not  allowed  Preachers,  may 

not  expound. 

50.  Strangers  not  admitted  to  preaeh  with- 

out showing  their  Licence. 

51.  Strangers  not  admitted   to  preach    in 

Cathedral  Churches  without  sufiicieni, 
Authority. 

52.  The  Names  of  strange  Preachers  to  bo 

noted  in  a  Book. 

53.  No  public  Opposition  between  Preachers. 


124  CANON 

64.  The  Licences  of  Preacliers  refusing  Con- 
formity to  be  void. 

55.  The  Form  of  a  Prayer  to  he  used  by  all 
Preachers  before  their  Sermons. 

66.  Preachers  and  Lecturers  to  read  Divine 
Service,  and  administer  the  Sacraments 
twice  a  Year  at  the  least. 

57.  The  Sacraments  not  to  be  refused  at  the 
hands  of  unpreaching  Ministers. 

68.  Ministers  reading   Divine   Service,  and 

administering  the  Sacraments,  to  wear 
Surplices,  and  Graduates  therewithal 
Hoods. 

69.  Ministers  to  catechise  every  Sunday. 

60.  Confirmation  to  be  performed  once  in 

three  Years. 

61.  Ministers  to  prepare  Children  for  Con- 

firmation. 

62.  Ministers  not    to  marry  any  Persons 

without  Banns  or  Licence. 

63.  Ministers  of  exempt  Churches  not  to 

marry  without  Banns  or  Licence. 

64.  Ministers  solemnly  to  bid  Holy-days. 

65.  Ministers  solemnly  to  denounce  Kecu- 

sants  and  Excommunicates. 

66.  Ministers  to  confer  with  Recusants. 

67.  Ministers  to  visit  the  Sick. 

68.  Ministers   not  to  refuse  to  christen  or 

bury. 

69.  Ministers  not  to  defer   Christening,  if 

the  Child  be  in  danger. 

70.  Ministers  to  keep  a  Register  of  Christ- 

enings, Weddings,  and  Burials. 

71.  Ministers  not  to  preach,  or  administer 

the  Communion,  in  private  Houses. 

72.  Ministers    not    to    appoint     public    or 

private  Fasts  or  Prophecies,  or  to 
exorcise,  but  by  Authority. 

73.  Ministers  not   to  hold  private  Conven- 

ticle?. 

74.  Decency  in  Apparel  enjoined  to  Min- 

isters. 

75.  Sober  Conversation  required    in    Min- 

isters. 

76.  Ministers  at  no  time  to  forsake  their 

Calling. 

Schoolmasters. 

77.  None  to  teach  School  without  Licence. 

78.  Curates  desirous  to  teach,  to  be  licensed 

before  others. 

79.  The  duty  of  Schoolmasters. 

Things  appertaining  to  Churches. 

80.  The  Great  Bible,  and  Book  of  Common 

Prayer,  to  be  had  in  every  Church. 

81.  A  Font  of  Stone  for  Baptism  in  every 

Church. 

Communion-Table   in  every 


82. 

83. 

84. 
85. 


A  decent 
Church. 

A    Pulpit    to    be    provided    in    every 
Church. 

A  Chest  for  Alms  in  every  Church. 

Churches  to  be  kept  in  sufficient  Repa- 
rations. 


87, 


CANON 

Churches  to  be  surveyed,  and  the  decays 
certified  to  the  High  Commissioners. 

A  Terrier  of  Glebe-lands  and  other 
Possessions  belonging  to  Churches. 

Churches  not  to  be  profaned. 


Churchwardens  or  Quest-men,  and  Side-^men 
or  Assistants. 

89.  The  choice  of  Churchwardens,  and  their 

Account. 

90.  The  choice  of  Side-men,  and  their  joint 

office  with  Churchwardens. 

Parish- Clerks. 

91.  Parish-Clerks  to  be  chosen  by  the  Min- 

ister. 

Ecclesiastical  Courts  belonging  to  the  Arch- 
bishop's Jurisdiction. 

92.  None  to  be  cited  into  divers  Coiu-ts  for 

Probate  of  the  same  Will. 

93.  The  rate  of  Bona  Notahilia  liable  to  the 

Prerogative  Court. 

94.  None  to  be  cited  into  the  Appeals  or 

Audience,  but    dwellers  within    the 
Archbishop's  Diocese,  or  Peculiars. 

95.  The  Restraint  of  double  Quarrels. 

96.  Inhibitions  not  to  be  granted  without 

the  Subscription  of  an  Advocate. 

97.  Inhibitions  not  to  be  granted,  until  the 

Appeal  be  exhibited  to  the  Judge. 

98.  Inhibitions  not  to  be  granted  to  factious 

Appellants,  unless  they  first  subscribe. 

99.  None  to  marry  within  the  Degrees  pro- 

hibited. 

100.  None    to    marry    under    Twenty-one 

Years,  without  their  Parents'  consent. 

101.  By  whom  Licences  to  marry  without 

Banns  shall  be  granted,  and  to  what 
sort  of  persons. 
Security  to  be  taken  at  the  granting 
of  such  Licences,  and  under  what 
Conditions. 

103.  Oaths  to  be  taken  for  the  Conditions. 

104.  An  Exception  for  those  that  are  in 
Widowhood. 

No  sentence  for  Divorce  to  be  given 

upon  the  sole  confession  of  the  parties. 
No  Sentence  for  Divorce  to  be  given 

but  in  open  Court. 
In  all  sentences  for  Divorce,  Bond  to 

be  taken  for  not  marrying  during  each 

other's  life. 

108.  The  Penalty  for  Judges  offending  in 

the  Premises. 

Ecclesiastical  Courts  belonging  to  the  Juris- 
diction of  Bishops  and  Archdeacons,  and 
the  Proceedings  in  them. 

109.  Notorius  Crimes  and  Scandals  to  be 

certified  into  Ecclesiastical  Courts  by 
Presentment. 

110.  Schismatics  to  be  presented. 


102. 


105. 


106. 


107. 


CANON 


CANON 


125 


111.  Disturbers   of  Divine    Service  to    be 

presented. 

112.  Non-Communicants   at  Easter  to    be 

presented. 

113.  Ministers  may  present. 

114.  Ministers  shall  present  Recusants. 

115.  Ministers  and  Churoliwardens  not  to 

be  sued  for  presenting. 

116.  Churchwardens  not  bound  to  present 

oftener  than  twice  a  year. 

117.  Churchwardens  nut  to  be  troubled  for 

not  presenting  oftener  than  twice  a 
year. 

118.  The  old  Churchwardens  to  make  their 

Presentments    before    the    new    be 
sworn. 

119.  Convenient   time   to    be  assigned   for 

framing  Presentments. 

120.  None  to  be  cited  into  Ecclesiastical 

Courts   by  process  of   Quorum  No- 
mina. 

121.  None  to  be  cited  into  several  Courts 

for  one  Crime. 

122.  No  Sentence  of  Deprivation  or  Deposi- 

tion   to    be    pronounced    against    a 
Minister,  but  by  the  Bishop. 

123.  No  Act  to  be  sped  but  in  open  Court. 

124.  No  Court  to  have  more  than  one  Seal. 

125.  Convenient  Places  to  be  chosen  for  the 

keeping  of  open  Courts. 

126.  Peculiar  and  inferior  Courts  to  exhibit 

the  original  Copies  of  Wills  into  the 
Bishop's  Eegistry. 

Judges  Ecclesiastical,  and  their  Surrogates. 

127.  The  Quality  and  Oath  of  Judges. 

128.  The  QuaUty  of  Surrogates. 

Proctors. 

129.  Proctors  not  to  retain  Causes  without 

the  lawful  Assignment  of  the  Parties. 

130.  Proctors  not  to  retain  Causes  without 

the  Counsel  of  an  Advocate. 

131.  Proctors  not  to  conclude  in  any  Cause 

without  the  Knowledge  of  an  Ad- 
vocate. 

132.  Proctors  prohibited  the  Oath,  In  ani- 

mam.  doraini  sui. 

133.  Proctors  not  to  be  clamorous  in  Court. 

JRegistrars. 

134.  Abuses  to  be  reformed  in  Registrars. 

135.  A  certain  rate  of  Pees  due  to  all  Eccle- 

siastical OflScers. 

136.  A  Table  of  the  Kates  and  Fees  to  be 

set  up  in  Courts  and  Registries. 

137.  The  whole  Fees  for  showing  Letters  of 

Orders,  and  other  Licences,  due  but 
once  in  every  Bishop's  time. 

Apparitors. 
X38.  The  Number  of  Apparitors  restrained. 


Authority  of  Synods. 

139.  A  National  Synod  the  Chm-ch  Repre- 

sentative. 

140.  Synods  conclude  as  well  the  absent  as 

the  present. 

141.  Depravers  of  the  Synod  censured. 

CANONS  OF  1640.  On  the  27th  May, 
1640,  the  Archbishop  of  Canterbury  stated 
before  the  Convocation  that  the  Canons 
agreed  upon  in  the  sacred  synod  had  been 
read  before  the  king  and  the  privy  council, 
and  unanimously  approved.  They  were  as 
follows : 

I.  With  regard  to  the  Royal  Authority 
and  Supremacy. 

II.  For  the  better  keeping  of  the  day  of 
his  Majesty's  most  happy  inauguration. 

III.  For  suppressing  the  growth  of 
Popery. 

IV.  Against  Socinianism. 

V.  Against  sectaries. 

VI.  An  oath  enjoined  for  the  preventing 
of  all  innovations  in  doctrine  and  govern- 
ment. 

VII.  A  declaration  concerning  some  rites 
and  ceremonies. 

[Declares  the  standing  of  the  communion 
table  sideways  imder  the  east  window  of 
every  chancel  or  chapel,  to  be  in  its  own 
nature  indifferent,  and  that  therefore  no 
religion  is  to  be  placed  therein,  or  scruple  to 
be  made  thereof.] 

VIII.  Of  preaching  for  conformity. 

IX.  One  Book  of  Articles  of  inquiry  to  be 
used  at  all  parochial  visitations. 

X.  Concerning  the  conversation  of  the 
clergy. 

XI.  Chancellor's  patents. 

XII.  Chancellors  alone  not  to  censure  any 
of  the  clergy  in  sundry  cases. 

XIII.  Excommunication  and  absolution 
not  to  be  pronounced  but  by  a  priest. 

XIV.  Concerning  commutations  and  the 
disposing  of  them. 

XV.  Touching  concurrent  jurisdiction. 
XVT.  Concerning  licences  to  marry. 
XVII.  Against  vexatious  citations. 

These  canons  were  ratified  by  the  king 
under  the  great  seal,  June  30th,  1640.  An 
attempt  was  made  at  the  time  to  set  aside 
their  authority,  upon  the  plea  that  convoca- 
tion could  not  lawfully  continue  its  session 
after  the  dissolution  of  parliament,  which 
took  place  on  the  5th  of  May;  but  the 
opinion  of  all  the  judges  taken  at  the  time 
was  unanimously  in  favour  of  the  legality 
of  their  proceeding,  as  appears  by  the 
following  document : — 

"The  convocation  being  called  by  the 
king's  writ  under  the  great  seal,  doth  con- 
tinue until  it  be  dissolved  by  writ  or  com- 


126 


CANON 


mission  under  the  great  seal,  notwithstanding 
the  parhament  be  dissolved. 
"  14th  May,  1640. 

"  Jo.  Finch. 

"  C.  S.  H.  Manchester. 

"  John  Bramston. 

"  Edward  Littleton. 

"Ealphe  Whitfield. 

"  Jo.  Bankes. 

"Ro.  Heath." 

An  Act  of  Parliament,  passed  in  the  thir- 
teenth year  of  Charles  II.,  leaves  to  these 
canons  their  full  canonical  authority,  whilst 
it  provides  that  nothing  contained  in  that 
.statute  shall  give  them  the  force  of  an  Act  of 
Parliament. 

The  acts  of  this  convocation  were  una- 
nimously confirmed  by  the  synod  of  York. 
— Cardwell,  vol.  ii.  p.  593,  vol.  i.  p.  380 ; 
WUkins,  CoTic.  vol.  iv.  p.  538. 

These  canons,  though  passed  in  convoca- 
tion, are  not  in  force  for  the  following 
reason :  In  1639  a  parliamentary  writ  was 
directed  to  the  bishops  to  summon  these 
clergy  to  parliament  ad  consentiendum,  &o., 
and  the  convocation  writ  to  the  archbishops 
ad  iractand.  et  consentiend.  The  parliament 
met  on  the  13th  of  April,  1610,  and  was 
dissolved  on  the  15th  of  May  following. 
Now  though  the  convocation,  sitting  by 
virtue  of  the  first  writ  directed  to  the 
bishops,  must  fall  by  the  dissolution  of  that 
parliament,  yet  the  lawyers  held  that  they 
might  sit  till  dissolved  by  like  authority. 
But  this  being  a  nice  point,  a  commission 
was  granted  about  a  week  after  the  dissolu- 
tion of  the  parliament  for  the  convocation  to 
sit,  which  commission  the  king  sent  to  them 
by  Sir  Harry  Vane,  his  principal  Secretary 
of  State,  and  by  virtue  thereof  they  were 
turned  into  a  provincial  synod.  The  chief 
of  the  clergy  then  assembled  desired  the 
king  to  consult  aU  the  judges  of  England  on 
±his  matter,  which  was  done :  and  upon 
debating  it  in  the  presence  of  his  council, 
they  asserted  under  their  hands  the  power 
of  convocation  in  making  canons.  Upon 
this  the  convocation  sat  a  whole  month, 
and  composed  a  Book  of  Canons,  which  was 
approved  by  the  king  by  the  advice  of  his 
privy  council,  and  confirmed  under  the  broad 
seal.  The  objection  against  the  Canons  was 
that  they  were  not  made  pursuant  to  the 
statute  25  Hen.  VIII.,  because  they  were 
made  in  a  convocation,  sitting  by  the  king's 
writ  to  the  archbishops,  after  the  parliament 
was  dissolved,  though  there  is  nothing  in 
the  statute  which  relates  to  their  sitting  in 
time  of  parliament  only. 

After  the  Restoration,  when  an  Act  was 
passed  to  restore  the  bishops  to  their  ordinary 
jurisdiction,  a  proviso  was  made  that  the 
Act  Bhould  not  confirm  the  Canons  of  1640. 


CANON 

This  clause  makes  void  the  royal  confirma- 
tion. Hence  we  may  conclude  that  canons 
should  be  made  in  a  convocation,  the  parlia- 
ment sitting ;  that  being  so  made,  they  are 
to  be  confirmed  by  the  sovereign ;  and  that 
without  such  confirmation  they  do  not  bind 
the  laity,  much  less  any  order  or  rule  made 
by  a  bishop  alone,  where  there  is  neither 
custom  nor  canon  for  it. — ^Phillimore's  Burn, 
iv.,  App. 

CANON  OP  SCRIPTURE.  The  books 
of  Holy  Scripture  as  received  by  the  Church, 
who,  being  the  "witness  and  keeper  of 
Holy  Writ,"  had  authority  to  decide  what 
is  and  what  is  not  inspired.  (See  Scripture  ; 
BibU.) 

CANON  OP  THE  LITURGY.  (See 
Liturgy.')  Canon  is  used  in  the  service  of 
the  Church  to  signify  that  part  of  the 
communion  service,  or  in  the  Roman  Church 
the  mass,  which  follows  immediately  after 
the  Sanctus  and  Hosanna  ;  corresponding  to 
that  part  of  our  service  which  begins  at  the 
prayer,  "  We  do  not  presume"  &c.  It  is 
so  called  as  being  the  fixed  rule  of  the  Liturgy, 
which  is  never  altered.  Properly  speaking, 
the  canoii  ends  just  before  the  Lord's  Prayer, 
which  is  recited  aloud ;  the  canon  being 
said  in  a  low  voice.  In  the  First  Book  of 
King  Edward  VI.,  the  word  is  used  in  this 
sense,  viz.  in  the  Visitation  of  the  Sick, 
after  the  Gospel,  the  service  proceeds  as 
follows : 

"  Tlie  Preface.    The  Lord  be  with  you. 

Answer.     And  with  thy  spirit. 

^  Lift  up  your  hearts,  &c. 

Unto  the  end  of  the  canon." 

The  Anaphora  of  the  Greek  Church 
resembles  the  canon  of  the  Roman.  (See 
Anaphora.) — Jebb.  Professor  Cheetham  in 
Bict.  Christ.  Antig.  \ol.  i.  269. 

CANONICI.    (See  aergy.) 

CANON  LAW.  The  canon  law  which 
regulates  the  discipline  of  the  Romish 
Church  consists,  1.  Of  the  Decree  of 
Gratian  (Decretum  Gratiani),  a  compilation 
made  by  a  Benedictine  monk,  whose  name 
it  bears,  at  Bologna  in  Italy,  in  1150,  and 
made  up  of  the  decrees  of  different  popes 
and  councils,  and  of  several  passages  of  the 
holy  fathers  and  other  reputable  writers. 

2.  Of  the  Becretals,  collected  by  order  of 
Pope  Gregory  IX.,  in  the  year  1230,  in  five 
books. 

3.  Of  the  compilation  made  by  order  of 
Boniface  VIII.,  in  1297,  known  by  the  name 
of  the  Sixth  Book  of  Becretals,  because 
added  to  the  other  five,  although  it  is  itself 
divided  into  five  books. 

4.  Of  the  Clementines,  as  they  are  called, 
or  Decretals  of  Pope  Clement  V.,  published 
in  the  year  1317  by  John  XXII. 

5.  Of  other  decretals,  known  under  the 
name  of  Extravagantes,  so  called  because 


CANON 

not  contained  in  the  former  decretals. 
These  Extra vagantes  are  twofold : — the  first, 
called  common,  containiug  constitutions  of 
various  popes  down  to  the  year  1483 ;  and, 
secondly,  the  particular  ones  of  John  XXII. 

These,  containing  besides  tlie  decrees  of 
popes  and  the  canons  of  several  councils, 
constitute  the  body  of  the  canon  law. 
The  constitutions  of  subsequent  popes  and 
councils  have  iilso  the  force  of  canons, 
although  not  hitherto  reduced  into  one  body, 
nor  digested,  as  the  others,  under  proper 
ieads,  by  any  competent  authority.  These, 
together  with  some  general  customs,  or 
peculiar  ones  of  different  places,  having  the 
force  of  laws,  and  certain  conventions  entered 
into  between  the  popes  and  different  Roman 
Catholic  states,  determine  the  discipline  of 
the  Church  of  Eome.  But  all  that  has  no 
relation  to  this  country,  where  there  is  in 
fact  no  such  thing  as  canon  law  apart  from 
the  general  or  king's  ecclesiastical  law,  as 
TDefore  stated,  though  some  of  it  was  derived 
from  old  canon  law,  as  some  other  English 
law  was  from  Roman. 

CANON,  CANONICUS.  I.  General 
Mstory  of  the  term.  It  was  originally  applied 
not  only  to  the  clergy,  but  to  all  officials  of 
the  Church,  as  readers,  singers,  porters, 
whose  names  were  enrolled  on  the  list  of 
ecclesiastics,  the  Kavaiv  (Latine  matricula, 
tabula,  album :  Thomas.,  Vet.  et  Nov. 
Discip.  i.,  ii.  34  ;  Bingh.  i.,  iv.  §  10)  ;  or  even 
persons  who  were  maintained  by  the  alms 
of  the  Church,  widows,  orphans,  &c.  (Bing- 
liam,  ib.)  But  in  time  the  word  came  to  be 
restricted  to  those  clergy  who  lived  under 
some  special  rule,  more  particularly  such  as 
iformed  the  staff  of  the  bishop  and  resided 
either  in  or  near  his  dwelling.  Thus 
Augustine,  Ambrose,  Eusebius  of  Vercelli, 
Hikry  of  Aries,  and  others,  lived  under  the 
same  roof  with  their  clergy  and  imposed 
a  kind  of  monastic  discipline  upon  the 
whole  society.  The  second  council  of 
Toledo,  531,  mentions  schools  conducted  by 
the  "  canonioi  in  domo  ecclesias  sub  Episcopi 
prjBsentia,"  and  Gregory  of  Tours,  Hist.  x. 
ad  Jin.,  speaks  of  the  "  mensa  canonica,"  the 
common  meal  of  the  canonici  established 
"by  Bandinus,  archbishop  of  Tours.  But 
Chrodegang,  archbishop  of  Metz  (760)  was 
•the  founder  of  a  rule  for  canonical  life  which 
anet  with  more  general  approbation  than  any 
other.  It  was  based  upon  the  Benedictine. 
The  bishop  was  to  be  as  the  abbot  of  the 
community,  the  archdeacon  as  the  prior; 
all  were  to  confess  to  the  bishop  in  Lent 
and  Autumn.  The  day  was  portioned  out 
into  hours  for  divine  service,  manual  labour 
and  study ;  there  was  a  common  dormitory 
and  refectory,  and  a  distinctive  garb.  Thus 
the  life  of  the  society  was  assimilated  to  that 
oi  monks ;    but    with    certain   differences. 


CANON 


127 


Canons  were  prnuitted  to  retain  their 
private  property  during  theii  life  (after 
death  it  passed  into  the  possession  of  tlie 
canonical  body);  they  took  no  vows,  and 
were  forbidden  to  wear  the  monk's  cowl.  In 
short,  as  regulated  by  the  rule  of  Chrode- 
gang, canons  might  be  described  as  secular 
clergy  living  in  a  semi-monastic  style. 
Charles  the  Great  endeavoured  to  impose 
the  system  of  Chrodegang  on  all  the  clergy 
in  his  empire,  and  although  he  was  not 
successful  in  this  attempt,  the  number  of 
colleges  for  canons,  besides  the  cathedral 
chapters,  of  which  nearly  all  in  France, 
Germany,  and  Italy  adopted  the  rule,  rapidly 
increased.  The  rule  of  Chrodegang,  however, 
was  not  very  long  maintained  anywhere  in 
its  integrity.  The  canons  were  continually 
striving  for  exemption  from  the  bishop's 
authority,  for  a  share  in  the  government  of 
the  diocese,  and  for  more  independence  in 
the  management  of  their  property.  In 
many  instances  the  common  dormitory  and 
refectory  were  given  up;  each  canon  had 
his  own  house  in  the  precincts  of  the  cathe- 
dral or  collegiate  church.  Some  of  them 
lived  a  part  of  the  year  on  the  property 
which  formed  the  separate  endowment  (pras- 
benda)  of  their  stall,  at  a  distance  from  the 
cathedral  or  coUegiate  church,  discharging 
their  duties  there  by  means  of  vicars.  They 
were  not  uncommonly  married  men,  or  lived 
in  a  state  of  concubinage.  In  fact,  in  the 
eleventh  century  the  rule  of  Chrodegang 
had  become  almost  extinct. 

II.  Canonical  Life  in  England.  The  con- 
version of  England  was  mainly  accomplished 
by  monks  of  the  Roman  or  Irish  school,  and 
consequently  the  monastic  system  had  a 
peculiar  claim  upon  the  reverence  of  the 
English  people.  The  missionary  bishop 
being  himself  a  monk,  naturally  surrounded 
himself  with  monks  as  his  fellow-labourers, 
and  thus  the  original  chapter  of  most  of  the 
earliest  cathedrals  in  England  was  monastic 
in  character.  As  Christianity  spread  and 
the  dioceses  were  divided,  the  principal 
church  of  the  new  district  was  commonly 
made  a  bishop's  see,  and  here  the  bishop, 
whether  a  monk  or  not,  generally  formed 
his  chapter  out  of  the  parochial  clergy  of  the 
city,  who  were,  of  course,  secular  priests. 
As  members  of  the  chapter  they  were  called 
canons.  But  the  rule  of  Chrodegang  never 
found  favour  in  England.  A  few  of  the 
bishops  who  were  eithtr  foreigners  or  who 
had  been  trained  in  amtinental  schools,  such 
as  Gisa,  bishop  of  Wells,  1061,  Leofric, 
bishop  of  Exeter,  1056,  Thomas,  archbishop 
of  York,  1070,  tried  to  introduce  it,  but  with 
very  partial  and  short-lived  success.  The 
oldi-r  type  of  monachism  died  out  in  England 
during  the  period  of  the  Danish  invasion, 
but  the  monastic  system  was  revived  in  the 


128 


CANON 


tenth  century  under  Odo  and  Dunstan  in  a 
more  aggressive  form.  Monacliism  was  ex- 
tolled as  the  highest  type  of  life;  a  much 
sharper  distinction  than  had  existed  before 
was  di'awn  between  regular  and  secular 
clergy,  and  from  several  of  the  cathedrals 
canons  were  removed  to  make  way  for 
monks.  Cnut  and  Harold,  indeed,  founded 
colleges  for  secular  canons,  but  these  were 
exceptions  to  the  general  practice  (Freeman, 
J^orm.  Conq.  ii.  443;  Stubhs'  Introd. 
to  Epp.  Cant.  xxi.  and  de  Invent,  cruc. 
Introd.  ix.).  Down  to  the  tiiiie  of  Henry 
VIII.  some  of  the  cathedrals  were  served 
by  monks,  others  by  secular  canons.  The 
number  of  canons  varied  from  about  twelve 
in  some  of  the  Welsh  cathedrals,  to  as  many 
as  forty  or  fifty  in  some  of  the  English. 
Most  of  the  stalls  were  separately  endowed, 
and  as  holding  this  endowment  or  prebenda, 
the  canons  were  also  called  prebendaries. 
(See  Prebendary.)  The  whole  body  of 
canons  seldom  resided  at  the  same  time 
in  the  cathedral  precincts,  but  the  number 
of  residents,  and  non-residents,  varied  very 
much  at  different  times  and  in  different 
places. 

ni.  Canons  Residentiary,  and  others.  In 
most  cathedrals  the  number  of  residents 
gradually  became  fixed,  seldom  more  than 
nine,  or  less  than  four,  and  when  a  vacancy 
occurred,  the  bishop,  or  the  dean,  or  the 
Crown,  or  the  residentiary  body  filled  it  up 
by  electing  one  of  the  non-resident  canons, 
and  in  some  cases  strangers  could  be  ap- 
pointed. It  is  a  question  now  whether  the 
bishops  must  first  make  a  stranger  a  preben- 
dary where  that  limitation  existed  before. 
When  the  monasteries  were  dissolved  in  the 
sixteenth  century,  the  monastic  cathedrals 
were  remodelled,  a  dean  and  a  fixed  number 
of  canons  being  substituted  for  the  abbot  and 
monks.  These  are  called  cathedrals  of  the 
new  foundation,  as  distinguished  from  those 
which,  having  always  been  served  by 
secular  canons,  remained  unaltered  in  consti- 
tution, and  are  therefore  called  cathedrals  of 
the  old  foundation.  By  the  Cathedral  Act  of 
1840,  the  number  of  residentiary  canons  was 
in  many  cases  reduced  tq  four,  and  the  non- 
residents were  deprived,  with  some  few  ex- 
ceptions, of  their  endowments,  although 
they  are  still  called  prebendaries,  and  retain 
their  stall  in  the  choir,  and  on  certain  occa- 
sions their  voice  in  the  chapter.  The 
appointment  of  all  non-residentiary  canons, 
in  cathedrals  of  the  old  foundation,  was 
given  by  the  same  Act  to  the  bishop  of  the 
diocese ;  and  he  may  appoint  twenty-four 
"  honorary  canons "  with  stalls  in  the  new 
cathedrals ;  and  by  custom  assign  them  a 
preaching  turn.  They  have  no  emoluments 
and  no  voice  in  the  chapter,  and  are  quite 
distinct  in    origin    from    the    non-resident 


CANON 

canons  or  prebendaries  in  cathedrals  of  the 
old  foundation.     (See  Cathedral.') 

IV.  Canons  Regular,  to  be  carefully  dis- 
tinguished from  the  secular  canons.  Pope 
Nicolas  II.  had  endeavoured,  in  1060,  to 
revive  the  rule  of  Chrodegang,  which  had 
become  generally  relaxed.  But  Ivo,  bishop 
of  Chartres,  and  others  went  further,  and 
formed  some  communities  which  were 
modelled  entirely  on  the  monastic  pattern, 
the  members  even  renouncing  all  right  to 
private  property.  They  were  called  regular 
canons  of  St.  Augustine  (or  more  briefly 
Augustinian  shortened  again  into  Austin 
canons),  because  their  rule  was  said  to  be 
based  upon  some  regulations  of  St.  Augus- 
tine. They  were  also  commonly  called 
black  canons,  because  their  habit  was  a  long 
black  cassock,  and  a  black  cloak  and  hood 
over  a  white  rochet.  A  new  and  strictly 
reformed  order  of  Austin  canons  was  founded 
in  1121  by  Norbert,  afterwards  archbishop 
of  Magdeburg  at  Premonstre  in  Champagne, 
whence  they  were  called  Premonstratensian 
canons,  and  sometimes  "  white  canons,"  from 
their  white  habit.  The  earliest  house  of 
"regular  canons"  in  England  was  that  of 
St.  Juhan  and  St.  Botolph,  at  Colchester, 
founded  about  1105.  The  chief  patrons  of 
the  order  were  William  of  Corbeuil,  prior  of 
St.  Osyth's,  afterwards  archbishop  of 
Canterbury,  and  Athelwulf,  prior  of  Nostel, 
afterwards  bishop  of  Carlisle.  This  was  the 
only  cathedral  in  England  which  was  served 
by  Austin  canons.  The  first  foundation  of 
Premonstratensian  or  white  canons  in 
England  was  at  Newhouse,  in  Lincolnshire, 
in  1146,  but  the  abbey  of  Welbeck,  in 
Nottinghamshire,  ranked  as  the  chief 
English  home  of  the  order.  There  were 
some  other  varieties  of  canons  regular  in 
England,  as  the  order  of  Sempringham  or 
G-ilbertine  canons,  instituted  by  St.  Gilbert 
at  Sempringham,  in  Lincolnshire,  in  1148, 
for  men  and  women,  and  the  canons  regular 
of  the  Holy  Sepulchre  or  of  the  Holy  &oss, 
but  none  were  so  numerous  or  important  as 
the  Augustinian  and  Premonstratensian 
orders. — Eobertson,  Ch.  Hist.  ii.  211-13, 
222,  252,  512-13,  774 ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim, 
i.  494,  538  ;  ii.  47,  and  note  122. 

V.  Canons  Minor,  Priests  in  cathedrals, 
not  members  of  either  the  great  or  small 
chapter,  who  are  responsible  for  performing 
the  service,  but  not  preaching.  In  some  of 
the  old  cathedrals  they  are  called  priest 
vicars  and  vicars  choral,  and  the  singing  men 
lay  vicars.  In  some  they  form  a  separate 
corporation  with  or  without  the  lay  vicars. 
Their  numbers  vary,  but  are  seldom  lesa 
than  four,  and  must  not  exceed  six,  and 
they  are  always  appointed  by  the  chapter 
(of  residentiaries)  by  3  &  4  Vict.  113,  s. 
54  (1840),   except  where   the  dean    alone 


CANONICAL 

had  the  appointment  before.  Since  that  Act 
their  stipend  was  not  to  be  less  than  £150. 
Minor  canonries  are  "  cathedral  preferment " 
within  the  Pluralities  Act,  1  &  2  Vict.  c. 
106,  and  no  minor  canon  now  may  hold 
any  benefice  more  than  six  miles  from  the 
cathedral.  They  are  also  among  the  persons 
to  whom  cathedral  livings  must  be  given 
by  the  Act  of  1841.  Several  later  Acts  have 
been  passed  relating  to  their  estates  where 
they  are  separate  corporations,  in  1864-5.  [H.] 

CANONICAL.  That  which  is  done  in 
accordance  with  the  canons  of  the  Church. 

CANONICAL  HOURS.  The  first,  third, 
the  sixth,  and  the  ninth  hours  of  the  day, 
that  is,  six,  nine,  twelve,  and  three  o'clock, 
are  so  denominated.  Bishop  Patrick  re- 
marks that  "  the  Universal  Church  anciently 
observed  cei-tain  set  hours  of  prayer,  that 
all  Christians  throughout  the  world  might 
at  the  same  time  join  together  to  glorify 
God;  and  some  of  them  were  of  opinion 
that  the  angelic  host,  being  acquainted  with 
those  hours,  took  that  time  to  join  their 
prayers  and  praises  with  those  of  the 
Church."  The  directions  in  the  Apostolical 
Constitutions  are  as  follows :  "  Offer  up  your 
prayers  in  the  morning,  at  the  third  hour, 
at  the  sixth,  and  at  the  ninth,  and  in  the 
evening ;  in  the  morning  returning  thanks 
that  the  Lord  hath  sent  you  light,  and 
brought  you  through  the  perils  of  the  night ; 
at  the  third  hour,  because  at  that  hour  the 
Lord  received  sentence  of  condemnation 
from  Pilate;  at  the  sixth,  because  at  that 
hour  he  was  crucified  ;  at  the  ninth,  because 
at  that  hour  all  things  were  in  commotion 
at  the  crucifixion  of  our  Lord,  as  trembling 
at  the  bold  attempt  of  the  wicked  Jews,  and 
at  the  injury  offered  to  their  Master ;  in  the 
evening,  giving  thanks  that  he  has  given 
thee  the  night  to  rest  from  thy  daily  labours." 
See  also  Tertul.  de  Orat.  ii.  26 ;  Cyprian,  de 
Orat.  Dom.  xxii. 

The  names  given  by  the  Anglo-Saxons  to 
the  canonical  hours  were  uhtsang,  prime- 
sang,  undersang,  middaysang,  noon  sang, 
evensang,  and  nightsang.  These  corre- 
spond with  prime,  tierce,  sext,  and  nones,  at 
the  first,  third,  sixth,  and  ninth  hours  of  the 
day,  counting  from  six  in  the  morning ; 
vespers  at  the  eleventh  hour,  and  compline 
at  the  twelfth.  Matins  was  always  to  be 
said  at  some  time  after  midnight. — Wilkins' 
CoTic.  torn.  i.  252 ;  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  Aug., 
iii.,  iv.     [H.] 

CANONICAL  OBEDIENCE.  (See 
Orders.)  The  obedience  which  is  due, 
according  to  the  canons,  to  an  ecclesiastical 
superior.  Every  clergyman  takes  an  oath 
of  canonical  obedience  to  his  bishop  when 
he  is  instituted  to  a  benefice  or  licensed  to 
a  cure. 

CANONISATION.     (See  Beatification, 


CANONEY 


129 


and  Saints.")  A  ceremony  in  the  Roman 
Church,  by  which  persons  deceased  are 
ranked  in  the  catalogue  of  saints.  It  succeeds 
beatification.  The  word  was  derived  from  the 
custom  of  inserting  the  names  of  saints  in  the 
canon  of  the  mass,  before  martyrologies  were 
composed.  When  a  person  is  to  be  canon- 
ised, the  pope  holds  four  consistories.  In 
the  last  he  orders  the  report  concerning  the 
deceased  to  be  read,  and  then  takes  the 
votes  of  the  assembled  cardinals  and  pre- 
lates, whether  he  is  to  be  canonised  or  not. 
The  ceremony  is  performed  in  the  church  of 
St.  Peter's  with  great  pomp. 

Canonisation  was  not  known  to  the 
Christian  Church  tiU  the  tenth  century, 
though  before  that  time  festivals  in  honour 
of  holy  men  had  been  wont  to  be  held.  In 
the  Council  of  Lateran  (a.d.  993),  John  XV. 
added  to  the  names  of  saints  that  of  Udalrio, 
bishop  of  Augsburg;  but  it  was  not  till 
1170  that  the  pope  (Alex.  III.)  claimed  the 
reservation  of  the  rite  to  the  Roman  see. 
Innocent  III.  confirmed  this  in  a  bull  issued 
in  1200.  It  has  been  objected  against 
canonisation,  that  it  is  performed  by  human 
beings,  who  assume  a  power  of  rendering 
some  one  an  object  of  divine  worship,  who 
in  this  life  was  no  more  than  mortal ;  that 
it  is  a  direct  violation  of  the  Saviour's  com- 
mand, "Judge  not; "  and  that  it  lies  at  the 
foundation  of  that  idolatry  of  which  the 
Church  of  Rome  is  charged. — Broughton, 
Biblio.,  vol.  i. ;  Mabillon,  Acta  Sanctor.  Ord. 
Bened.,  vol.  vii. ;  del.  Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  vol.  ii.  275-427. 

CANONRY.  A  canonry  is  a  name  of 
office,  and  a  canon  is  the  officer.  But  con- 
versely, zprebendary  is  the  holder  of  a  pre- 
lend,  which  is  the  maintenance  or  stipend 
both  of  the  one  and  the  other.  It  seems 
most  likely  that  the  word  canon  meant  to 
designate  one  who  resided  at  the  cathedral 
church  constantly,  and  followed  the  rule 
of  Divine  service  there :  so  the  application 
of  the  word  at  home  and  abroad  would  seem 
to  indicate.  (But  see  Canon.)  Thus^  till  a 
late  enactment,  3  &  4  Vict.  c.  1 13,  the  word 
canon  was  restricted  in  cathedrals  of  the 
old  foundation  to  the  residentiaries.  Pre- 
bendary was  statutably  applied  to  all, 
because  all  had  a  "  prsebenda,"  either  affixed 
stipend,  or  an  estate  for  life  :  while  in  the 
cathedrals  of  new  foundation  all  were  called 
canons  or  prebendaries,  because  all  were 
equally  bound  to  residence ;  but  they  were 
much  fewer  than  the  canons  and  preben- 
daries of  the  old  foundations,  who  were 
24  at  Exeter  and  Hereford,  27  at  Lichfield, 
28  at  Chichester,  30  at  St.  Paul's  and  York, 
49  at  Wells,  52  at  Lincoln,  and  53  at  Salis- 
bury. (See  Report  of  Cathedral  Commission, 
1854.)  By  s.  93  of  that  Act  the  word 
"  canon "    alone    is    interpreted    to    mean 

K 


130 


CANTATE 


canons  residentiary,  who  at  first  were  the 
only  ones  meant  to  be  retained,  and  yet  by 
s.  1,  all  members  of  the  chapter  are  to  be 
called  canons.  But  the  Act  was  altered 
iu  its  course  through  parliament,  with 
considerable  carelessness.  And  the  non- 
residentiary  canons  or  prebendaries  were 
finally  retained,  and  their  endowments  only 
taken  away.  In  the  "new  cathedrals," 
where  there  were  no  non-residentiaries 
before,  the  bishops  were  allowed  to  appoint 
twenty-four  honorary  canons;  but  they 
have  no  votes  in  the  chapter,  as  the  pre- 
bendaries have  in  different  degrees  in  the  old 
cathedrals.  (See  Cathedral.)  The  bishops 
have  the  same  power  in  the  stUl  newer 
cathedrals  founded  in  this  century,  in  most 
of  which  there  is  no  chapter  at  all. 

The  fellowships  of  the  collegiate  church 
in  Manchester,  on  its  elevation  into  a 
cathedra],  were  erected  into  canonries,  and 
the  warden  of  former  times  into  dean.  But 
they  all  have  parochial  duties  too,  under  the 
Manchester  Parish  Division  Act.     [G.] 

Canonry,  or  chanonrie,  in  Scotland,  was 
the  same  as  the  cathedral  precinct  in  Eng- 
land. Thus  at  Aberdeen  the  canonry  in- 
cluded the  cathedral,  bishop's  palace,  pre- 
bendal  houses,  gardens,  and  an  hospital, 
all  surrounded  by  a  stone  wall.  (Kennedy's 
Annals  of  Aberdeen.')  The  cathedral  to\vn 
of  Rosemarkie,  or  Fortrose,  in  the  diocese 
of  Ross,  was  sometimes  called  the  canonry 
town,  or  channery  town. 

CANTATE  DOMINO.  This  Psalm  was 
inserted  in  the  Prayer  Book  of  1552,  as  an 
alternative  for  the  Magnificat,  to  be  sung  or 
said  after  the  first  lesson  at  evening  service. 
It  is  not  easy  to  understand  why  this  ad- 
dition was  made,  unless  it  was  to  please  the 
Genevans,  who  disliked  the  use  of  the 
Magnificat.  There  are  parallel  expressions 
in  the  Magnificat  and  "  Cantate  Domino," 
which  probably  led  to  its  being  selected  as 
an  alternative.  (^t^'&hmVs  Annotated  P.  B. 
pp.  33-34.) 

CANTICLE.  This  literally  signifies 
song,  but  it  is  peculiarly  applied  to  a 
canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament,  called 
in  Hebrew  the  Song  of  Songs,  that  is,  the 
most  excellent  of  all  songs,  called  also  the 
Song  of  Solomon.  The  word  cantide  in  our 
Prayer  Book  is  applied  to  the  Benedicite, 
and  was  so  first  used  in  King  Edward's 
Second  Book.  But  it  also  denotes  all  those 
hymns  which  are  said  or  sung  after  the 
lessons  at  the  morning  and  evening  services. 
With  the  exception  of  the  Te  Deum,  all 
are  taken  from  Holy  Scripture. 

CANTORIS.  In  cathedral  churches  except 
Ely  (see  Abbot),  the  stall  of  the  dean  (De- 
canus)  is  to  the  right  on  entering  the  choir, 
hence  the  south  side  was  called  Decani ;  and 
as  the  PriEcentor  (Cantor)  sat  opposite,  his 


CAPITAL 

side  was  called  "of  the  Cantor,"  or  Can- 
toris. 

CANTUS  AMBROSIANUS.  (See  Am- 
brosian  Bite.)  The  term  given  generally 
to  church  music  in  the  West  before  the 
time  of  Gregory.  It  is  derived  from  St. 
Ambrose,  who  ^introduced  into  the  West 
the  system  of  hymn  singing,  and  antiphonal 
psalm  chanting,  which  he  is  said  to  have 
learnt  at  Antiooh,  from  whence  he  brought 
his  melodies.  Ambrose  admitted  the  four 
Greek  scales  (Dorian,  Phrygian,  Lydian, 
Mixo-Lydian)  corresponding  to  our  scales 
of  D,  E,  P,  G,  without  accidentals ;  the 
melodies  -(vritten  in  each  ranging  only  from 
the  key  note  to  its  octave,  and  ending 
properly  on  the  key  note,  thence  called  the 
final. 

CAPITAL.  The  highest  member  of  a 
pillar. 

The  capital  consists  of  the  abacus,  the 
bell,  the  neck,  or  astragal,  and  each  of  these 
varies  in  the -several  styles,  as  well  in  form 
as  in  relative  importance.  A  few  of  the 
more  prominent  variations  may  be  enume- 
rated. 

In  the  Saxon  period,  the  abacus  is  usually 
a  low,  flat,  tmrnoulded  slab ;  the  rest  of  the 
capital,  if  it  has  any  character,  approaches 
that  of  the  succeeding  style. 

In  the  Norman  capital  the  abacus  is 
square,  of  considerable  thickness,  generally 
slightly  bevelled  at  the  lower  side,  and 
sometimes  moulded.  The  bell,  resting  on 
a  cylindrical  shaft,  and  fitted  with  a  square 
abacus,  is  circular  at  the  bottom,  and  be- 
comes square  at  the  top,  and  the  way  of  re- 
solving the  round  into  the  square  gives  it 
its  pecuHar  character.  In  examples,  how- 
ever, of  any  richness,  the  abundance  of 
decoration  often  obscures  its  constructive 
character. 

In  the  period  of  transition  to  Early  Eng- 
lish, the  abacus  sometimes  becomes  octa- 
gonal, seldom  however  a  regular  octagon, 
but  a  square  with  the  comers  slightly  cut 
off.  It  is  also  sometimes  circular.  The 
upper  surface  continues  fiat,  but  the  under 
part  is  more  frequently  moulded.  The  bell 
often  approaches  the  Classic  capital  in 
design,  and  sometimes  even  in  treatment, 
as  at  Canterbury ;  but  this  is  a  rare  amount 
of  excellence.  More  frequently  a  lotus-like 
flower  rises  from  the  neck,  and  curls  beneath 
the  abacus.  The  neck  is  still  a  mere  round 
bead. 

In  the  next,  or  Lancet  period,  the  abacus 
more  frequently  becomes  circular,  the  top 
is  seldom  flat,  the  mouldings  usually  con- 
sist of  two  rounds,  with  a  deep  undercut, 
hollow  between,  the  upper  one  a  little  over- 
hanging the  under,  and  in  the  hollow  a 
trad  of  nail-head  or  dog-tooth  is  often 
found.     The  bell,  also,  is  deeply  undercut. 


CAPITAL 

and  iu  some  instances,  where  effect  is 
souglit  in  moulding  rather  than  in  carving, 
it  is  re^Deated ;  but,  in  moderately  rich 
examples,  the  bell  is  usually  covered  with 
foliage  of  which  the  stems  spring  from  the 
neck,  generally  crossing  one  another  as 
they  rise,  and  breaking  into  leaves  near 
the  top,  where  they  throw  off  a  profusion 
of  crisped  foliage,  which  curls  imder  the 
abacus ;  a  stray  leaf,  in  very  rich  and 
rather  late  examples,  sometimes  shooting 
up,  over  the  hollow,  to  the  upper  member  of 
the  abacus.  The  whole  treatment  of  this 
foliage  in  capitals  and  corbels,  where  it 
follows  the  same  law,  has  sometimes  a 
boldness  and  a  grace,  though  it  never 
deserts  its  conventional  type,  of  which  no 
description,  and  no  engraving  even,  except 
on  a  large  scale,  can  convey  an  idea.  The 
neck  of  the  Early  English  capital  is  gener- 
ally either  a  rounded  bowtel  of  rather  more 
than  half  a  cylinder,  or  a  semi-hexagon, 
the  latter  with  the  sides  sometimes  slightly 
hoUowed. 

In  the  Geometrical  or  early  Decorated 
period,  the  abacus  continues  round.  It  is  no 
longer  flat  at  the  top :  the  scroll  moulding 
hegins  to  appear,  and  sometimes  a  hollow  in- 
tervenes between  it  and  the  first  member  of 
the  bell.  The  bell,  when  moulded,  rather 
follows  the  routine  of  the  last  style ;  but,  when 
foHated,  the  leaves  or  flowers,  without  losing 
anything  of  the  force  and  boldness  of  the 
latter,have  a  naturalness  never  approached  in 
any  other  style:  we  begin  to  recognise  the 
oak,  the  hawthorn,  or  the  maple,  as  familiar 
friends,  and  no  longer  need  to  employ 
conventional  terms  to  disignate  their  foliage, 
or  the  method  of  its  treatment. 

In  the  late  Decorated  period,  the  scroU- 
moulding  is  generally  employed  for  the 
abacus  and  for  the  neck ;  the  ball-flower 
sometimes  occurs  in  the  hoUow  of  the 
abacus,  but  not  so  frequently  as  the  dog- 
tooth in  the  Lancet  period.  The  mouldings 
of  the  bell  are  generally  the  roll  and  fillet, 
or  the  scroll,  in  some  of  their  forms ;  and 
the  foliage  entirely  loses  the  nature  of  the 
Geometrical,  without  recovering  the  force 
of  the  Early  EngUsh.  It  surrounds  the 
bell  as  a  chaplet,  instead  of  creeping  up  it, 
and,  instead  of  indicating  the  shape  which 
it  clothes,  converts  the  whole  between  the 
neck  and  the  abacus  into  a  flowered  top. 

In  the  Perpendicular  period,  the  abacus 
is  sometimes  so  nearly  lost  in  the  bell,  or 
the  bell  in  the  abacus,  that  it  is  hard  to 
separate  them.  The  form  of  both  becomes 
generally  octagonal,  and  a  great  poverty 
of  design  is  apparent :  this  is  the  case  in 
ordinary  instances  of  pfllars  with  entire 
capitals.  In  later  examples,  and  where 
there  are  greater  pretensions,  the  capital 
does  not  extend  to  the  whole  pillar,  but 


CAPUCHINS 


131 


the  outer  order  of  the  arches  is  continued 
to  the  base,  without  the  intervention  of  a 
capital,  only  the  inner  order  being  sup- 
ported and  stopped  by  an  attached  shaft, 
or  bowtel,  with  its  capital,  and  so  the 
capital  loses  all  its  analogy  with  the  classic 
architrave,  and  no  longer  stops  the  eye  by 
a  horizontal  line.  The  effect  is  very  in- 
ferior and  monotonous,  as  is  generally  the 
case  in  that  style. 

CAPITULUM.  (See  Cliapier.-) 
CAPITULARY.  Literally  a  collection 
of  "  capitula  "  or  little  chapters.  The  term 
was  commonly  applied  to  the  series  of  laws 
and  ordinances  issued  from  time  to  time  by 
the  early  Prankish  sovereigns,  and  as  the 
great  majority  of  laws  in  those  collections 
were  of  an  ecclesiastical  character,  it  denoted 
generally,  though  not  always,  a  series  of 
laws  relating  to  ecclesiastical  affairs.  The 
earliest  capitulary  in  the  edition  of  Baluze, 
is  Childebert's  Constitution  for  the  Abo- 
lition of  Idolatry,  a.d.  554.  But  by  far 
the  most  important  are  those  of  Pepin  le 
Bref,  A.D.  Ib'i,  and  Charles  the  Great.  Tlie 
pubhc  capitularies  of  the  latter  number 
about  sixty,  each  containing  many  capitula 
or  articles,  amounting  in  all  to  1150.  The 
latest  capitularies  are  those  of  Carloman,  in 
882,  after  which  there  is  a  long  suspension 
of  legislation.  The  Frankish  laws  were 
proposed  in  the  assembUes  held  twice  a- 
year ;  the  clergy  and  laity  sat  either 
separately  or  together,  according  to  the 
nature  of  the  subject  xmder  discussion ;  bat 
the  right  of  initiative  and  decision  rested 
with  the  sovereign,  and  the  decrees  were 
issued  in  his  name.  Besides  those  which 
were  distinctly  ecclesiastical,  there  were 
others  which  dealt  with  every  department 
of  human  life,  moral,  social,  and  political. 
What  share  the  freeholders  as  a  body  had 
in  all  this  legislation  is  a  subject  which  has 
been  debated,  and  cannot  be  entered  upon 
here.  (See  Hallam,  Middle  Ages,  ch.  ii. 
part  ii. ;  and  Guizot's  Lectures  on  Oivilisor- 
tion.)  The  first  formal  collection  of  capitu- 
laries was  one  edited  in  four  books  by 
Angesius,  Abbot  of  Pontenella,  who  died  in 
833.  It  contains  the  laws  of  Charles  the 
Great  and  Louis  the  Pious.  Benedict,  a 
deacon  of  Mayence,  added  three  more  books 
about  the  year  842,  containing  those  of 
Lothaire,  Charles  and  Louis,  sons  of  Louis 
the  Pious.  Father  Simon  ^published  those 
of  Charles  the  Bald,  and  these  editions  have 
been  supplemented  by  anonymous  compilers. 
(Capitularia  Regum  Francoriim,  by  Stephen 
Baluze,  Paris,  1677,  2  vols;  Herzog's  Beal- 
Encyclopadie,  Article  Capitularien ;  Pertz, 
Monumenta  Germanise  Historica.') 

CAPUCHINS.  Monks  of  the  order  of 
St.  Francis.  They  owe  their  origin  to 
Matthew  de  Baschi,  a   Franciscan   of  the 

K  2 


132 


CAPUCHINS 


ducliy  of  Urbino,  who,  having  seen  St. 
Francis  represented  with  a  sharp-pointed 
capudie,  or  cowl,  began  to  wear  the  like 
in  1525,  with  the  permission  of  Pope  Cle- 
ment VII.  His  example  was  soon  followed 
hy  two  other  monks,  named  Louis  and 
Raphael  de  Fossembrun;  and  the  pope,  by 
a  brief,  granted  these  thi-ee  monks  leave  to 
retire  to  some  hermitage,  and  retain  their 
new  habit.  The  retirement  they  chose  was 
the  hermitage  of  the  Camaldolites  near 
Massacio,  where  they  were  very  charitably 
received. 

This  innovation  in  the  habit  of  the  order 
gave  great  offence  to  the  Franciscans,  whose 
provincial  persecuted  these  poor  monks,  and 
obliged  them  to  fly  from  place  to  place. 
At  last  they  took  refuge  in  the  palace  of 
the  Duke  de  Camerino,  by  whose  credit 
they  were  received  under  the  obedience  of 
the  conventuals,  in  the  quality  of  Hermits 
Minors,  in  the  year  1527.  The  next  year, 
the  pope  approved  this  union,  and  confirmed 
to  them  the  privilege  of  wearing  the  square 
capuche,  and  admitting  among  them  all 
who  would  take  the  habit.  Thus  the  order 
of  the  Capuchins,  so  called  from  wearing 
the  capuche,  began  in  the  year  1528. 

Their  first  establishment  was  at  Cohnen- 
zono,  about  a  league  from  Camerino,  in  a 
convent  of  the  order  of  St.  Jerome,  which 
had  been  abandoned ;  but,  their  numbers 
increasing,  Louis  de  Fossembrun  built 
another  small  convent  at  Montmelon,  in 
the  territory  of  Camerino.  The  great  num- 
ber of  conversions  which  the  Capuchins  made 
by  their  preaching,  and  the  assistance  they 
gave  the  people  in  a,  contagious  distemper 
with  which  Italy  was  afflicted  the  same 
year,  1528,  gave  them  an  universal  esteem. 

In  1529,  Louis  de  Fossembrun  built  for 
them  two  other  convents,  the  one  of  Alva- 
cina  in  the  territory  of  Fabriano,  the  other 
at  Fossembrun  in  the  duchy  of  Urbino. 
Matthew  de  Bassi,  being  chosen  their  vicar- 
general,  drew  up  constitutions  for  the 
government  of  this  order.  They  enjoined, 
among  other  things,  that  the  Capuchins 
should  perform  Divine  service  without 
singing ;  that  they  should  say  but  one 
mass  a  day  in  their  convents  ;  they  forbade 
the  monks  to  hear  the  confessions  of  seculars, 
and  enjoined  them  always  to  travel  on  foot ; 
they  recommended  poverty  in  the  ornaments 
of  thdir  church,  and  prohibited  in  them  the 
use  of  gold,  silver,  and  silk  ;  the  pavilions 
of  the  altars  were  to  be  of  stuff,  and  the 
chalices  of  tin. 

This  order  soon  spread  itself  all  over 
Italy  and  Sicily.  In  1573,  Charles  IX. 
demanded  of  Pope  Gregory  XIII.  to  have 
the  order  of  Capuchins  established  in 
France,  which  that  pope  consented  to ;  and 
their  first  settlement  in  that  kingdom  was 


CARDINAL 

in  the  little  town  of  Picpus  near  Paris; 
which  they  soon  quitted  to  settle  at  Meu- 
don,  from  whence  they  were  introduced 
into  the  capital  of  the  kingdom.  In  1606, 
Pope  Paul  V.  gave  them  leave  to  accept 
an  establishment  which  was  offered  them' 
in  Spain.  They  even  passed  the  seas  tO' 
labour  in  the  conversion  of  the  infidels ; 
and  their  order  became  so  considerable,  that 
it  was  divided  into  more  than  sixty  pro- 
vinces, consisting  of  near  1600  convents, 
and  25,000  monks,  besides  the  missions  of' 
Brazil,  Congo,  Barbary,  Greece,  Syria,  and 
Egypt ;  but  these  mmibers  have  been  much 
reduced  by  the  suppression  of  the  religious; 
orders  in  France  and  Italy. 

Among  those  who  have  preferred  the- 
poverty  and  humility  of  the  Capuchins  to 
the  advantages  of  birth  and  fortune,  was 
the  famous  Alphonso  d'Bste,  duke  of  Modena 
and  Eeggio,  who,  after  the  death  of  his  wife 
Isabella,  took  the  habit  of  this  order  at 
Munich,  in  the  year  1626,  under  the  nam& 
of  Brother  John-Baptist,  and  died  in  the 
convent  of  Castelnuovo,  in  1644.  In  France, 
likewise,  the  great  Duke  de  Joyeuse,- after 
having  distinguished  himself  as  a  general',, 
became  a  Capuchin  in  September,  1587. — 
Stubbs'  Soames'  Moslieim,  ii.  518;  Hist, 
des  Ord.  Rel.,  vol.  vii.  c.  27 ;  Broughton's' 
Biblio.,  vol.  i. 

CAPUCHINES.  Capuchin  nuns.  Their 
foundress  was  Maria  Laurentia  Longa,  a 
noble  lady  of  great  piety  and  devotion. 
She  built  a  monastery  of  virgins,  called 
"  Our  Lady  of  Jerusalem  "  (a.d.  1538),  in 
which  was  observed  the  third  rule  of  St. 
Francis.  Afterwards  they  embraced  the 
more  rigorous  rule  of  St.  Clara,  from  the 
austerity  of  which  they  had  the  name  of 
jVm7!s  of  the  Passion,  and  that  of  Capuchines 
from  the  habit  they  took,  which  was  that 
of  the  Capuchins. 

After  the  death  of  their  foundress,  an- 
other moDastry  of  Capuchines  was  estab- 
lished at  Rome,  near  the  Quirinal  palace,, 
and  was  called  the  Monastery  of  the  Holy 
Sacrament ;  and  a  third,  in  the  same  city,, 
built  by  Cardinal  Baronius.  These  founda- 
tions were  approved,  in  the  year  1600,  by 
Pope  Clement  VIII.,  and  confirmed  by- 
Gregory  XV.  There  were  afterwards 
several  other  establishments  of  Capuchines, 
in  partiotdar  one  at  Paris,  in  1604,  founded 
by  the  Duchesse  de  Mercosur,  who  put 
crowns  of  thorns  on  the  heads  of  the  young- 
women  whom  she  placed  in  her  monastery. 

CAPUT  JBJUNIL  The  head  or  be- 
ginning of  the  fast :  an  old  name  for  the 
first  day  of  Lent.     (See  Ash  Wednesday.^ 

CAPDTIUM.     (SeeSood.) 

CARDINAL.  A  title  originally  given 
to  those  presbyters  and  deacons  who  were- 
permanently    attached   to    any   church  as- 


CARDINAL 

being  the  principal  clergy  of  that  church, 
the  hinges  upon  which  all  the  work  turned. 
As  applied  to  a  certain  office  in  the 
Roman  Church  the  following  statements 
comprise  the  important  historical  facts  : 

1.  The  institution  of  the  oflfice  has  been 
ascribed  by  respectable  Roman  Catholic 
writers  to  Christ  himself,  to  the  apostle  of 
their  faith,  to  the  Roman  bishop  Evaristus, 
to  Hyginus,  Marcellus,  Boniface  III.,  and 
others.  But  we  only  know  that  the  deacons 
and  presbyters  and  bishops  of  the  regions  or 
twenty-eight  parishes  into  which  Rome  was 
■divided  bore  this  name.  The  title  was  also 
■conferred  upon  the  suffragan  bishops  of 
Ostia,  Albano,  and  others  in  the  immediate 
vicinity,  but  without  any  other  rights  than 
those  which  were  connected  appropriately 
with  the  ministerial  ofBce. 

2.  The  import  of  the  term  was  varied 
still  more  in  the  ninth  century,  and  espe- 
cially in  the  eleventh,  by  Nicolas  II.,  in 
A.D.  1059,  who  in  his  constitution  for  the 
election  of  the  Roman  Pontiff,  not  only 
appointed  his  seven  suffragan  bishops  as 
members  of  the  pope's  ecclesiastical  councU, 
but  also  conferred  on  them  the  right  of 
initiative  in  the  election  of  the  pope,  which 
had  to  be  subsequently  ratified  by  the 
assent  of  the  other  clergy  and  the  people, 
find  also  the  emperor. 

This  is  the  important  period  in  history 
when  the  first  foundation  was  laid  for 
rendering  the  hierarchy  of  the  Church  in- 
•dependent  both  of  the  clergy  and  of  the 
^secular  power.  This  period  has  not  been 
noticed  so  particularly  by  historians  as  its 
importance  requires.  They  seem  especially 
^;o  have  overlooked  the  fact,  that  the  famous 
Hildebrand  (Gregory  VII.),  in  the  year 
3.073,  concerted  these  measures  for  the 
independence  of  the  Church,  as  the  follow- 
ing extract  will  show :  "  It  was  the  deep 
design  of  Hildebrand,  which  he  for  a  long 
time  prosecuted  with  tmwearied  zeal,  to 
bring  the  pope  wholly  within  the  pale  of 
the  Church,  and  to  prevent  the  interference, 
in  his  election,  of  all  secxilar  influence  and 
arbitrary  power.  And  that  measure  of  the 
council  which  wrested  from  the  emperor  a 
right  of  so  long  standing  and  which  had 
never  been  called  in  question,  may  de- 
servedly be  regarded  as  the  master-piece 
of  popish  intrigue,  or  rather  of  Hildebrand's 
cunning.  The  concession  which  disguised 
this  crafty  design  of  his  was  expressed  as  fol- 
lows :  that  the  emperor  should  ever  hold  from 
the  pope  the  right  of  appointing  the  pope." 

3.  As  might  have  been  expected,  this 
privilege  was  afterwards  contested  by  the 
princes  of  the  German  States,  especially 
by  those  of  Saxony  and  the  House  of 
Hohenstaufen.  But  these  conflicts  uni- 
formly resulted  in  favour  of  the  ambitious 


CARDINAL 


133 


designs  of  the  pope.  A  momentary  con- 
cession, granted  under  the  pressure  of  cir- 
cumstances, became  reason  sufficient  for 
demanding  the  same  over  afterwards  as  an 
established  right.  In  the  year  a.d.  1179, 
Alexander  III.,  through  the  canons  of  the 
Lateran,  confined  the  election  of  the  pope 
exclusively  to  the  cardinals,  so  that,  after 
this,  the  ratification  of  the  emperor,  clergy, 
and  people,  was  no  longer  of  any  import- 
ance. Something  similar  was  also  repeated 
by  Innocent  III.,  a.d.  1215,  and  Innocent 
IV.,  A.D.  1254.  The  former  had  aheady, 
in  ■the  year  a.d.  1198,  renounced  the  civil 
authority  of  Rome,  and  ascended  the  papal 
throne.  In  the  year  127^4,  the  conclave  ot 
cardinals  for  the  election  of  the  pope  was 
fully  established  by  Gregory  X.,  and  remains 
the  same  to  this  day. 

4.  The  college  of  cardinals,  which,  until 
the  twelfth  century,  had  been  restricted 
to  Rome  and  its  vicinity,  has  since  been 
greatly  enlarged,  so  as  to  become  the  su- 
preme court  of  the  Romish  Church  through- 
out the  world.  Priests  of  illustrious  name 
in  other  provinces  and  countries  have  been 
elevated  to  the  dignity  of  cardinals.  Of 
this,  Alexander  III.  gave  the  first  example 
in  the  year  1165,  by  conferring  the  honour 
upon  Galdinus  Sala,  archbishop  of  Milan, 
and  upon  Conrad,  archbishop  of  Mentz. 
But,  to  the  injury  of  the  Church,  the  greater 
part  have  ever  been  restricted  to  the  limits 
of  Rome  and  Italy. 

5.  The  formal  classification  of  the  car- 
dinals into  three  distinct  orders,  1.  cardinal 
bishops ;  2.  cardinal  presbyters ;  3.  cardinal 
deacons,  was  made  by  Paul  II.  in  the 
fifteenth  century.  He  also  gave  them, 
instead  of  the  scarlet  robe  which  they  had 
worn  since  the  year  1244,  a  purple  rohe, 
from  whence  they  derived  the  name  of  the 
•purple ;  a  title  'indicative,  not  merely  of 
their  superiority  to  bishops  and  archbishops, 
but  of  their  regal  honours  and  rights. 
Boniface  VIII.  gave  them  the  title  of 
eminentissimi,  most  eminent ;  and  Pius  V., 
in  the  year  1567,  decrees  that  no  other 
should  have  the  name  of  cardinal. 

6.  The  number  of  cardinals  was  at  first 
not  less  than  seven ;  and,  after  having 
ranged  from  seven  to  fifty-three,  it  was 
reduced  again  in  the  year  1277  to  the 
minimum  above  mentioned.  The  General 
Assembly  of  the  Church  of  Basel  limited 
the  number  to  twenty-four  ;  but  the  popes 
from  this  time  increased  them  at  their 
pleasm-e.  Under  Leo  X.  there  were  sixty- 
five  cardinals :  Paul  IV.  and  Pius  V.  decreed 
that  the  maximum  should  be  seventy — 
equal  in  number  to  the  disciples  of  our 
Lord.  These  were  arranged  under  the 
following  grades :  1.  Six  cardinal  bishops, 
■with  the  following  titles : — the  bishops  of 


134 


CARMELITES 


Ostia,  Porta,  Albano,  Frascati,  Sabina,  and 
PalMstrina ;  2.  Fifty  cardinal  priests,  who 
were  named  after  the  parochial  and  cathe- 
dral churches  of  Eome ;  3.  Fourteen  car- 
dinal deacons,  who  were  named  after  the 
chapels.  This  number  was  seldom  full; 
but,  since  1814,  they  have  again  become 
quite  numerous. — Augusti. 

The  canons  in  some  foreign  cathedrals 
are  called  cardinals;  as  at  Milan  and  Sa- 
lerno. In  the  cathedral  of  St.  Paul's, 
London,  two  of  the  minor  canons  are  still 
so  designated.  Their  statutable  duties  are 
to  superintend  the  behaviour  of  the  mem- 
bers of  the  choir,  in  order  to  the  correction 
of  offenders  by  the  dean  and  chapter,  and 
to  see  to  the  burial  of  the  dead,  &c. — Jebb, 
Choral  Service;  Eobertson's  Blist.  of  Oh., 
ii.  584;  Stubbs'  Soames'  MosJieim,  ii.  24, 
25, 117,  505 ;  Jovet's  Sist.  des  Eel.,  vol.  i. 
pp.  213,  221. 

CARMELITES,  or  WHITE  PBIAES. 
Monks  of  the  order  of  Our  Lady  of  Mount 
Carmel.  They  claim  to  derive  their  origin 
from.  Elijah ;  but  their  real  history  is,  that 
in  the  middle  of  the  twelfth  century  a 
certain  Berthold,  a  Calabrian,  with  a  few 
conuades  migrated  to  Mount  Carmel,  and 
took  up  his  abode  in  a  place  where  tradition 
jjointed  out  that  Elias  had  hid  himself. 
This  community  increased  rapidly,  and 
Albert,  patriarch  of  Jerusalem,  gave  them 
a  rule  of  life  in  1205,  which  Pope  Honorius 
ni.  confirmed  in  1224. 

The  peace  concluded  by  the  emperor 
Frederic  II.  with  the  Saracens,  in  the  year 
1229,  so  disadvantageous  to  Christendom, 
and  so  beneficial  to  the  infidels,  occasioned 
the  CarmeUtes  to  quit  the  Holy  Land  under 
Alan,  the  fifth  general  of  the  order.  They 
founded  monasteries  at  Cyprus,  Messina, 
Marseilles,  and  many  other  places  in 
Europe,  and  soon  gained  considerable 
ground  in  England,  where  in  the  year 
1245  they  held  their  first  European  general 
chapter,  at  Aylesford.  They  were  mendi- 
cants, and  had  their  name  "  White  Friars  " 
from  the  colour  of  their  habit.  This  was 
changed  by  order  of  Honorius  IV. 

After  the  establishment  of  the  Carmelites 
in  Europe,  their  rule  was  in  some  respects 
altered:  the  first  time,  by  Pope  Innocent 
IV.,  who  added  to  the  first  article  a  precept 
of  chastity,  and  relaxed  the  eleventh,  which 
enjoins  abstinence  at  all  times  from  flesh, 
permitting  them,  when  they  travelled,  to 
eat  boiled  flesh.  Their  rule  was  again 
mitigated  by  the  Popes  Eugenius  IV.  and 
Pius  II.  Hence  the  order  is  divided  into 
two  branches,  viz.  the  Carmelites  of  the 
ancient  observance,  called  the  moderate  or 
mitigated,  and  those  of  the  strict  observance, 
who  are  the  barefooted  CarmeUtes ;  a  re- 
form set  on  foot,  in  1540,  by  St.  Theresa,  a 


CARPOCEATIANS 

nun  of  the  convent  of  Avila,  in  Castile : 
these  last  are  divided  into  two  congrega- 
tions, that  of  Spain  and  that  of  Italy. 

The  Carmelites  had  a  bitter  controversy 
with  the  Jesuits  in  the  seventeenth  century 
as  to  their  origin.  They  accused  Papebrock, 
a  learned  Jesuit,  of  erroneously  stating  that 
their  order  was  not  derived  from  Elijah,  and 
cited  him  before  Innocent  III.  In  Spain 
his  works  were  condemned ;  and  in  1697  aU 
the  controversial  writings  against  the  Car- 
melite theories  were  proscribed  by  the 
inquisition.  The  next  year,  however,  the 
pope  ordered  both  parties  to  leave  off 
wrangling,  and  to  stop  the  controversy. — 
Helyot,  Hist,  des  Ord.  Eel.,  vol.  i.  282; 
Broughton,  Biblio.,  vol.  i. ;  Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  vol.  ii.  123, 193. 

CAROLS.  Ital.  Carola,  fromLat.  Choreola. 
Hymns  sung  by  the  people  at  Christmas  in 
memory  of  the  song  of  the  angels,  which 
the  shepherds  heard  at  our  Lord's  birth. 

CARPOCRATIANS.  Heretics  who 
sprang  up  in  the  second  century ;  followers 
of  Carpocrates  of  Cajsarea. 

Eusebius  (fiisf.  £ccl.  iv.  7)  says  that  ac- . 
cording  to  Irenseus,  who  lived  in  the  second 
century,  Carpocrates  was  the  father  of  tne 
heresy  of  the  Gnostics;  and  it  is  true  that 
all  the  infamous  things  imputed  to  the 
Gnostics  are  ascribed  likewise  to  the 
Carpocratians.  Carpocrates  believed  in  one 
supreme  God,  but  also  admitted  .(Eons  as 
the  offspring  of  God;  the  creation  of  the 
world  from  evil  matter  by  angels ;  divine 
souls  unfortunately  enclosed  in  bodies  and 
the  like.  He  maintained  that  our  Lord 
Jesus  was  born  of  Joseph  and  Mary  in  the 
ordinary  course  of  nature,  and  was  only 
superior  to  other  men  in  fortitude  and 
greatness  of  soul ;  that  his  soul  only  was 
received  into  heaven,  his  body  remaining  on 
earth ;  and  accordingly  he  rejected  the 
resurrection  of  the  body.  He  gave  his 
disciples  licence  to  sin,  and  moreover  in- 
sisted on  the  necessity  of  their  sinning, 
asserting  that  a  man  cannot  arrive  at  per- 
fection, nor  deliver  himself  from  the  power 
of  the  princes  of  this  world,  as  he  expressed 
it,  without  having  passed  through  all  sorts 
of  criminal  actions:  laying  it  down  for  a 
maxim,  that  there  is  no  action  bad  in  itself, 
but  only  from  the  opinion  of  men. — Clem. 
Alex.  Strom,  iii. ;  Euseb.  ut  sup. 

Epiphanius  relates  of  himself,  that  in 
his  youth  he  accidentally  fell  into  company 
with  some  women  of  this  sect,  who  re- 
vealed to  him  the  most  horrible  secrets  of 
the  Carpocratians.  They  were  armed  with 
beauty  sufficient  to  make  an  impression  on 
a  person  of  his  age ;  but,  by  the  grace  of 
God,  he  says  he  escaped  the  snare  which 
the  devil  had  laid  for  him. — ^Epiph.  Exr, 
xxvi.  c.  17,  18. 


CAETHUSIANS 

Carpoorates  left  a  son,  Epiphanes,  who  at 
the  age  of  17  wrote  a  book,  which  contains 
the  tenets  of  his  father.  "It  is  doubtful 
whether  he  ought  to  be  called  a  Christian. 
Two  inscriptions  in  the  true  spirit  of  this 
'  philosopher,'  recently  discovered  in  Cyrene 
in  Africa,  have  given  rise  to  a  conjecture 
that  his  sect  continued  till  the  sixth 
century." — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  147. 

CARTHUSIANS.  A  religious  order, 
founded  in  the  year  1084  by  Bruno,  a  very 
learned  man,  a  native  of  Cologne,  and  master 
of  the  cathedral  school  at  Eheims.  The  name 
is  derived  from  Chartreuse,  a  rugged  and 
mountainous  spot  near  Grenoble,  to  which 
Bruno,  xmable  to  bear  the  conduct  of  his  arch- 
bishopManasses,  took  himself  with  six  com- 
panions. There  is  a  legend  that  Bruno  took 
his  resolution  of  retiring  into  the  desert, 
on  account  of  the  miraculous  utterances  of 
Kaimond  Dioore,  a  canon  of  Paris,  who, 
after  he  was  dead,  and  laid  on  the  bier,  on 
three  successive  days  raised  himself  and  said, 
"  By  the  just  judgment  of  God  I  am  ac- 
cused." "  By  the  just  judgment  of  God 
I  am  judged."  "  By  the  just  judgment  of 
God  I  am  condemned."  But  this  is  "ac- 
counted a  fable  even  in  the  Eomijsh  Church 
itself." — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  ii.  44. 

Hugo,  bishop  of  Grenoble,  assigned  to 
Bruno  a  spot  of  ground  where  he  built  his 
monastery.  He  adopted  the  rule  of  Bene- 
dict, though  with  more  austere  and  rigid 
observances :  and  his  successors  added  to 
the  severity  of  the  rules. 

In  the  year  1170,  Pope  Alexander  III. 
took  this  order  under  the  protection  of  the 
holy  see.  In  1391,  Boniface  IX.  exempted 
them  from  the  jurisdiction  of  the  bishops. 
In  1420,  Martin  V.  exempted  them  from 
paying  the  tenths  of  the  lands  belonging  to 
them ;  and  Julius  II.,  in  1508,  ordered  that 
all  the  houses  of  the  order,  in  whatever 
part  of  the  world  they  were  situated,  should 
obey  the  prior  of  the  Grand  Chartreuse,  and 
the  general  chapter  of  the  order. 

It  is  computed  that  until  the  recent  sup- 
pression of  religious  orders  in  Italy  and 
France,  there  were  a  hundred  and  seventy- 
two  houses  of  Carthusians,  whereof  five 
were  of  nuns,  who  practised  the  same  aus- 
terities as  the  monks,  four  in  France,  and 
one  at  Bruges.  They  are  divided  into  six- 
teen provinces,  each  of  which  has  two 
visitors.  There  have  been  several  canonised 
saints  of  this  order ;  four  cardinals,  seventy 
archbishops  and  bishops,  and  a  great  many 
very  learned  writers. 

There  are  a  few  monks  still  left  in  the 
Grand  Chartreuse,  but  the  chief  home  of 
the  order  is  at  Cowfold  in  Sussex,  where 
buildings  on  a  very  large  scale  have  re- 
cently been  erected.  The  Carthusians 
settled  in  England  about  the  year  1140. 


CATACOMBS 


135 


They  had  several  monasteries  hero,  particu- 
larly at  Witham,  in  Somersetshire ;  Hinton 
in  the  same  county;  Beauval,  in  Notting- 
hamshire ;  Kingston-upon-Hull ;  Mount 
Grace,  in  Yorkshire ;  Eppewort,  in  Lincoln- 
shire ;  Shene,  in  Surrey,  and  one  near 
Coventry.  In  London  they  had  a  famous 
monastery,  since  called,  from  the  Carthu- 
sians who  settled  there,  the  Charter  House. 
(See  Dugd  ale's  Monasticon ;  Mabillon's 
I'rief.  ad  ssecul.  vi.  pt.  ii.  of  his  Acta 
Sand.  Ord.  Bened.  p.  37 ;  Helyot's  Hist, 
des  Ord.,  vol.  vii.  p.  366.) 

CARTULARIES,  according  to  Jerom  de 
Costa,  were  papers  wherein  the  contracts, 
sales,  exchanges,  privileges,  immunities,  and 
other  acts  that  belong  to  churches  and 
monasteries  were  collected,  the  better  to 
preserve  the  ancient  deeds,  by  rendering 
frequent  reference  to  them  less  necessary. 

CASSOCK.  The  under  dress  of  all 
orders  of  the  clergy;  it  resembles  a  long 
coat,  with  a  single  upright  collar.  In  the 
Church  of  Rome  it  varies  in  colour  with  the 
dignity  of  the  wearer.  Priests  wear  black ; 
bishops,  purple ;  cardinals,  scarlet ;  and 
popes,  white.  In  the  Church  of  England, 
black  is  worn  by  all  the  three  orders  of  the 
clergy,  but  bishops,  upon  state  occasions, 
often  wear  purple  coats.  A  short  cassock 
(popularly  called  a  bishop's  apron)  is  gene- 
rally worn  by  bishops  and  dignitaries  of  the 
Church.  The  seventy-fourth  English  canon 
enjoins  that  beneficed  clergymen,  &c.,  shall 
not  go  in  public  in  their  doublet  and  hose, 
without  coats  or  cassocks. 

CASUIST.  One  who  studies  cases  of 
conscience. 

CASUISTRY.  The  doctrine  and  science 
of  conscienc?  and  its  cases,  with  the  rules 
and  principles  of  resolving  the  same ;  drawn 
partly  from  natural  reason  or  equity,  and 
partly  from  the  authority  of  Scripture,  the 
canon  law,  councils,  fathers,  &c.  To  casu- 
istry belongs  the  decision  of  all  difficulties 
arising  about  what  a  man  may  lawfully  do 
or  not  do  ;  what  is  sin  or  not  siQ ;  what 
things  a  man  is  obliged  to  do  in  order  to 
discharge  his  duty,  and  what  he  may  let 
alone  without  breach  of  it.  The  most  cele- 
brated writers  on  this  subject,  of  the  Church 
of  England,  are  Bishop  Jeremy  Taylor,  in 
his  '  jDuctor  Duhitantium : '  and  Bishop 
Sanderson,  in  his  '  Cases  of  Conscience.' 
There  was  a  professor  of  casuistry  in  the 
university  of  Cambridge,  but  the  title  of 
the  professorship  has  now  been  altered  to 
Moral  Philosophy. 

CASULA.     (See  Chasihle.) 

CATACOMBS.  Burying-places  near 
Rome ;  not  for  Christians  only,  but  for  all 
sorts  of  people.  There  is  a  large  vault 
about  three  miles  from  Rome,  used  for 
this  purpose ;    and    another    near    Naples, 


136 


CATAPHEYGBS 


That  at  Naples  consists  of  long  galleries 
cut  out  of  the  rock,  of  three  stories,  one 
above  another.  These  galleries  are  gene- 
rally about  twenty  feet  broad,  and  fifteen 
high.  Those  at  Borne  are  not  above  three 
or  four  feet  broad,  and  five  or  six  feet  high. 
They  are  very  long,  full  of  niches,  shaped 
according  to  the  sizes  of  bodies,  wherein  the 
bodies  were  put,  not  in  coffins,  but  only  in 
burial  clothes.  Many  inscriptions  are  still 
extant  in  them ;  and  the  same  stone  some- 
times bears  on  one  side  an  inscription  to 
heathen  deities  and  marks  of  Cliristianity 
on  the  other.  But  see .  a  full  account  of 
these  by  Canon  Venables  in  the  '  Dictionary 
of  Christian  Antiquities '  (Murray,  1883). 

CATAPHRYGES.  Christian  heretics, 
who  made  their  appearance  in  the  second 
century ;  they  had  this  name  given  to  them 
because  the  chief  promoters  of  this  heresy 
came  out  of  Phrygia.  They  followed 
Montanus's  errors.     (See  Montanists.) 

CATECHISM,  from  /can/x"",  to  teach  by 
word  of  mouth,  signifies  instruction  in  the 
first  rudiments  of  any  art  or  science,  com- 
municated by  asking  questions  and  hearing 
and  correcting  the  answers.  From  the  earliest 
ages  of  the  Church  the  word  has  been  em- 
ployed by  ecclesiastical  writers  in  a  more 
restrained  sense,  to  denote  instruction  in  the 
principles  of  the  Christian  religion  by 
means  of  questions  and  answers. 

I.  The  catechism  of  children  is  enjoined 
by  God  (Deut.  vi.  7 ;  Prov.  xxii.  6),  and  was 
always  practised  by  pious  men.  Josephus 
tells  us  that  the  Jews  were  above  all  things 
careful  that  their  children  should  be  in- 
structed in  the  Isw  (Jos.  Antiq.  lih.  iv.  c. 
8),  and  In  every  town  a  person  was  ap- 
pointed for  this  purpose.  At  the  age  of 
13  the  children  were  brought  to  the  house 
of  God  and  publicly  examined,  and  this 
has  been  suggested  as  the  object  of  our 
Saviour's  offering  himself  to  the  doctors  in 
the  temple  (Grotius  in  Luc.  ii.  42 ;  Words- 
worth, Oreek  lest.  i.  143).  The  word 
KaTTD^ilv  is  used  several  times  in  the  New 
Testament  (St.  Luke  i.  4 ;  Acts  xviii.  25 ; 
Kom.  ii.  18;  1  Cor.  xiv.  9;  Gal.  vi.  6,  &c.), 
with  the  general  meaning  "  insonere  ali- 
cujus  auribus,"  to  sound  instruction  in  one's 
ears  (Rose's  Parkhurst's  Lex.)  ;  and  among 
the  early  Christians  an  officer  was  appointed 
in  every  church  whose  business  it  was  to 
instruct  the  catechumens.  (See  Catechisi.) 
In  the  Apostolic  Constitutions  the  author 
orders  that  catechumens  be  instructed  in 
such  subjects  as  "  the  order  of  the  world," 
"  the  Providence  of  God,"  "  the  incarnation 
of  our  Lord,"  but  no  mention  is  made  of 
the  doctrine  of  the  Eucharist,  as  teaching 
on  this  point  came  after  baptism.  St. 
Augustine  wrote  to  "  brother  Deogratias  " 
a    treatise    on    Catechising,  in   which  he 


CATECHISM 

speaks  of  the  instruction  not  only  of  the 
ignorant,  but  also  of  those  who  had  re- 
ceived a  liberal  education,  and  of  gram- 
marians and  professional  speakers  (vol.  ix. 
pp.  265,  281-284,  Clark's  ed.  1873).  Series 
of  catechetical  lectures  by  Clemens  Alex- 
andrinus,  entitled  "  Pa;dagogus  "  (circ.  a.d. 
210),  and  Cyril  of  Jerusalem  (347)  are  extant. 

II.  In  the  mediaeval  Church  short  expla- 
nations of  the  Creed  and  Lord's  Prayer 
were  used.  The  Sarum  Use  orders  "  si  in- 
fans  sit  compatritus  et  commatritus  lis  injun- 
gatur,  ut  doceant  infantem  Pater  Noster,  et 
Ave   Maria  et  Credo  in  Deum,  vel  doceri 

facianV  But  it  appears  (rom  the  Injunc- 
tions of  1536  and  1538,  that  this  instruction 
was  not  systematic,  and  that  the  greatest 
ignorance  on  even  the  simplest  rudiments  of 
religious  knowledge  prevailed.  These  in- 
junctions direct  curates  to  recite  one  sen- 
tence of  the  Lord's  Prayer  or  Creed,  and 
afterwards  of  the  ten  commandments, 
several  times,  on  each  Sunday  or  holy 
day,  till  the  whole  was  learned :  and  each 
sentence  was  to  be  expounded.  In  the 
Prayer  Book  of  1549,  the  Catechism,  com- 
posed by  Dean  Nowell,  was  inserted:  in 
1552  the  preface  to  the  commandments, 
and  in  1604  the  part  relating  to  the 
sacraments,  said  to  be  by  Bishop  Overall, 
were  added.  Before  1662  the  catechism 
was  prefixed  to  the  order  of  confirmation, 
and  was  to  be  used  when  that  rite  was 
administered.  Canon  59  directs  that "  Every 
parson,  vicar,  or  curate,  upon  every  Sundav 
and  holy  day,  before  evening  prayer,  shall, 
for  half  an  hour  or  more,  examine  and 
instruct  the  youth  and  ignorant  persons  of 
his  parish,  in  the  ten  commandments,  the 
articles  of  the  belief,  and  in  the  Lord's 
Prayer  ;  and  shall  diligently  hear,  instruct, 
and  teach  them  the  catechism  set  forth  in 
the  Book  of  Common  Prayer.  And  all 
fathers,  mothers,  masters,  and  mistresses 
shall  cause  their  children,  servants,  and 
apprentices,  that  have  not  learned  the 
catechism,  to  come  to  the  church  at  the  time 
appointed,  obediently  to  hear,  and  to  be 
ordered  by  the  minister,  until  they  have 
learned  the  same."  Ministers  were  to  be 
severely  rebuked  and  punished  if  they 
neglected  this  duty.  The  rubric  orders  the 
catechising  to  take  place  after  the  second 
lesson  at  evening  prayer. 

In  the  office  of  public  baptism  the  mini- 
ster directs  the  godfathers  and  godmothers 
to  "  take  care  that  the  child  be  brought  to 
the  bishop,  to  be  confirmed  by  him,  so  soon 
as  he  or  she  can  say  the  Creed,  the  Lord's 
Prayer,  and  the  ten  commandments  in  the 
vulgar  tongue,  and  be  further  instructed  in 
the  Church  Catechism  set  forth  for  that 
purpose." 

III.  The  Canon  with  regard  to  catechising 


OATECHIST 

has  not  been  generally  observed :  the 
reason  for  this  was  that  the  clergyman  pre- 
ferred preaching.  King  James  refers  to  this 
neglect  in  a  letter  to  Archbishop  Abbot ; 
and  Evelyn  in  his  diary  says  that  he 
catechized  his  children  at  home,  "  those  ex- 
ercises universally  ceasing  in  parish  churches 
— all  devotion  being  now  placed  in  hearing 
sermons  of  speculative  things."  Another 
reason  may  be  in  the  universality  of 
Sunday  Schools,  where  the  children  learn 
vrhat  is  required.  But  perhaps  the  chief 
reason  is  that  the  difficulty  of  catechising  is 
great,  and  that  it  requires  a  special  gift, 
and  great  labour  and  study.  "  Let  not,"  says 
Bishop  Jebb, "  the  common  prejudice  be  en- 
tertained, that  catechizing  is  a  slight  and 
trifling  exercise,  to  be  performed  without 
pain  and  preparation  on  your  part.  This 
would  be  so,  If  it  were  the  mere  rote-work 
asking  and  answering  of  the  questions  in 
our  Church  Catechism :  but  to  open,  to 
explain,  and  familiarly  to  illustrate  those 
questions,  in  such  a  manner,  as  at  once  to 
reach  the  understanding  and  touch  the 
affections  of  little  children,  is  a  work  which 
demands  no  ordinary  acquaintance  at  once 
with  the  whole  scheme  of  Christian  the- 
ology, with  the  philosophy  of  the  human 
mind,  and  with  the  yet  profouuder  mys- 
teries of  the  human  heart.  It  has,  there- 
fore, been  well  and  truly  said,  by  I  recollect 
not  what  writer,  that  a  hoy  may  preach, 
but  to  catechize  requires  a  man."  See  Her- 
bert's Country  Parson — "  The  Parson 
Catechizing ; "  Hooker,  v.  xviii.  3 ;  Bather, 
Mints  on  the  Art  of  Catechizing,  Kiving- 
ton,  1849;  J.  J.  Blunt's  Parish  Priest 
(Murray),  pp.  186,  324;  J.  H.  Blunt's 
Annot.  P.  B.  p.  241  seq. ;  P.  B.  with  Com- 
mentary, S.  P.  C.  K.,  p.  119  ,•  Evan  Daniel's 
P.  B.  p.  359.     [H.] 

CATECHIST.  A  person  who  catechizes. 
There  were  officers  of  this  name  in  the 
ancient  Church;  but  they  did  not  form  a 
distinct  order.  Sometimes  the  bishop  or 
presbyters  catechized,  sometimes  the  cate- 
chists  were  selected  from  the  inferior  orders, 
as  readers,  &c.  But  it  was  an  office  of 
honour,  and  was  probably  assigned  to  the 
most  promising  man  in  each  church. 
Origen  was-  a  catechist  before  the  age  that 
he  could  be  ordained  deacon  (Euseb.  lib.  vi. 
c.  iii.),  and  St.  Chrysostom  performed  the 
office  when  a  presbyter  at  Antioch  {Horn. 
xxL  ad  pop.  Ant.)  Augustine's  treatise  de 
Catechizandis  Eudibus,  referred  to  in  the 
previous  article,  was  addressed  to  Deogratias 
as  a  deacon:  and  Cyril's  Catecheses  were 
delivered  by  him,  partly  as  a  deacon,  partly 
as  a  presbyter.  "The  word  Catechist, 
therefore,  implied  a  function,  not  a  class." — 
Bingham,  bk.  iii.  c.  10 ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant. 
(Murray),  voL  i.  p.  318. 


CATENA 


137 


CATECHUMENS.    (KaTijxoiixfvoi,  from 
Karrixftv,  to  teach  by  word  of  mouth).     A 
name  given,  in  the  first  ages  of  Christianity, 
to  the  Jews   or  Gentiles  who   were   being 
prepared    to  receive   baptism.     They  were 
instructed    by   persons    appointed   for   the 
purpose   (see   Catechist) ;    and  had  also    a 
peculiar  place  in   the  church  where   they 
used  to  be  taught,  which  was  called  the  place 
of  catechumens,  as  appears  by  the   canons 
of  the  Council  of  Neo-Ca?sarea.     The  cate- 
chumens were  not  permitted  to  be  present 
at  the  celebration  of  the  Holy  Eucharist ; 
but,  immediately  after  the  Gospel  was  read, 
the    deacons    cried    with    a    loud    voice : 
"Withdraw   in   peace,  you  catechumens " 
{Constit.    Apost.   viii.    5).       The    service 
from  the   beginning   to  the  Offertory  was 
called  Missa  catechumenorum.      The  cate- 
chumens, not  being  baptized,  were  not  to 
receive,  nor  so  much  as  permitted  to  see, 
the  consecrated  elements  of  the  Eucharist. 
Some  writers   suppose   that  they  received 
some  of  the  consecrated  bread  called  eulogise 
or  panis  benedictus ;  but  Bingham  shows 
that  this  idea  is  founded  on  a  misconstruc- 
tion of  a  passage  in  St.  Augustine,  and  that 
the  use  of  eulogise  was  not  known  in  the 
Church,  until  long  after  the  discipline  of 
the  catechumens  had  ceased.     According  to 
a  canon  of  the  Council  of  Orange,  they  were 
not  permitted  to  pray  with  the  faithful  or 
those    in  full    communion.      There    were 
several  degrees  of  favour  in  the  state  of  the 
cat-echumens :  at  first  they  were  instructed 
privately,  or  by  themselves  not  being  ad- 
mitted into  the  church.     But  with  regard 
to   the  existence  of  this  class  there    are 
doubts  :  it  rests  only  upon  inl'erence  drawn 
from  the  fifth  Canon  of  the  Coimcil  of  Neo- 
Csesarea  :  afterwards  they  were  admitted  to 
hear  sermons  in  the  church  ;  and  these  last 
were  called  audienles.  There  was  a  third  sort 
of  catechumens,  called  prostrati  or  genuflec- 
tentes,  because  they  were  present  and  con- 
cerned in  some  part  of  the  prayers  :  to  which 
we  may  add  a  fourth  degree,  which  were  the 
competentes  ;   for  so  they  were  called  when 
they  desired  to  be  baptized.— Bingham,  bk. 
X.,  c.  i.,  seq. ;  Dean  Plumptre  in  Diet.  Christ. 
Ant,  i.  p.  317. 

CATENA.  From  a  Greek  word  sig- 
nifying a  chain.  By  a  Catena  Patrura  is 
meant  a  string  or  series  of  passages  from 
the  writings  of  various  fathers,  and  ar- 
ranged for  the  elucidation  of  some  portions 
of  Scripture,  as  the  Psalms  or  Gospels. 
They  seem  to  have  originated  in  the  short 
scholia  or  glosses  which  it  was  customary  in 
MSS.  of  the  Scriptures  to  introduce  in  the 
margin.  These  by  degrees  were  expanded, 
and  passages  from  the  homilies  or  sermons 
of  the  fathers  were  added  to  them.  The 
most  celebrated  catena  is  the  Catena  Aurea 


138 


CATHAEI 


of  Thomas  Aquinas.  It  was  translated  at 
Oxford,  under  the  superintendence  of  Mr. 
J.  H.Newman,  of  Oriel  College — afterwards 
Cardinal  Newman.  But  it  appears  that 
Thomas  Aquinas  has  sometimes  falsified 
the  quotations  he  has  made  from  the 
fathers ;  and  the  whole,  as  a  commentary, 
is  inferior  to  the  commentaries  of  modern 
theologians.  (See  Commentaries;  Com- 
mentaiors.) 

CATHARI,  or  CATHAEISTS.  The 
last  surviving  sect  of  Manichaeans,  or 
Gnostics,  who  gave  themselves  that  name 
(from  Kadapos,  pure,)  to  indicate  their 
superior  purity.  There  were  many  differ- 
ent degrees  of  error  among  them,  but  the 
following  tenets  were  common  to  all :  That 
matter  was  the  source  of  all  evil;  that  the 
Creator  of  the  visible  world  was  not  the 
same  as  the  Supreme  Being ;  that  Christ 
had  not  a  real  body,  nor  was  properly 
speaking  horn,  nor  really  died ;  that  the 
bodies  of  men  were  the  production  of  the 
evil  principle,  and  were  incapable  of  sanctifi- 
cation  and  a  new  life ;  and  that  the  sacra- 
ments were  but  vain  institutions,  and 
without  power.  They  rejected  and  de- 
spised the  Old  Testament,  but  received  the 
New  with  reverence.  The  consequence  of 
such  doctrines  was,  of  course,  that  they 
made  it  the  chief  object  of  their  religion  to 
emancipate  themselves  from  whatever  was 
material,  and  to  macerate  their  bodies  to 
the  utmost ;  and  their  perfect  disciples,  in 
obedience  to  this  principle,  renounced  ani- 
mal food,  wine,  and  marriage.  The  state 
of  their  souls,  while  united  with  the  body, 
was  in  their  estimation  a  wretched  incarcera- 
tion, and  they  only  escaped  from  some  por- 
tion of  the  horrors  of  such  a  dungeon,  by 
denying  themselves  all  natural  enjoyments, 
and  escaping  from  the  solicitations  of  all 
the  senses. 

The  Catharists  in  the  twelfth  century 
spread  themselves  from  Bulgaria  over  most 
of  the  European  provinces,  but  they  met 
everywhere  with  extensive  persecution,  and 
are  not  heard  of  after  that  time. — Stubbs' 
Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  210  ;  ii.  148. 

CATHEDRA.  In  the  first  place  the 
word  meant  the  seat  or  throne  of  the 
bishop  in  his  church.  Eusebius  calls  the 
bishop  of  Jerusalem's  seat  "  6p6vov  anoaro- 
\iKov"  because  St.  James  the  apostle  first 
occupied  it :  and  so  Gregory  Nazianzen 
calls  that  at  Alexandria  "  MdpKov  Bpovov." 
(Bus.  lib.  vii.  c.  xix. ;  Greg.  Naz.  vol.  i.  p. 
377.)  It  was  also  called  "  B^^a  "  and  "  6p6voi 
v-^r)\os"  although  not  allowed  to  be  a 
pompous  or  splendid  erection,  but  only 
something  higher  than  the  seats  of  the 
presbyters.  One  of  the  charges  laid 
against  Paul  of  Samosata  was  that  ho  built 
himself  a  "  stately  tribunal,  as  one  of  the 


CATHEDRAL 

rulers  of  the  world."  (Euseb.  vii.  c.  xxx.) 
Episcopal  chairs  are  frequently  represented 
in  early  Christian  sculpture  or  mosaics,  and 
some  seats  cut  in  tufa  stone  in  the 
Catacombs  are  supposed  to  have  been 
bishops'  seats.  The  word  afterwards  was 
used  in  a  more  extended  sense  for  the 
bishops'  sees,  but  more  especially  for  the 
churches  in  which  were  the  bishops'  seats 
{Cone.  Tarracon.  a..v>.  bi.&),  ihe  principales 
Cathedrm,  or  Ecclesim  Cathedrales.  (See 
Cathedrals.) — Bing.,  bk.  ii.  c.  9  ;  Du  Cange. 

CATHEDRA  PETRI,  Festival  of.  There 
T/ere  two  days  as  early  as  the  eighth  century, 
on  which  the  "  bishopric  of  St.  Peter  "  was 
commemorated — Jan.  18  and  Feb.  22. 
This  perhaps,  may  be  due  to  the  idea  that 
St.  Peter  was  bishop  of  Antioch  before  he 
was  bishop  of  Rome  (see  St.  Leo's  Homilies, 
82-84  :  also  Epist.  cxix.  2,  vol.  i.  pp.  321 
1212,  sej.,  ed.  Ballerini).  But  it  would 
seem  more  probable  that  in  the  Roman  and 
GaUican  Chm'ches,  the  festival  was  observed 
on  different  days,  and  afterwards  these 
commemorations  were  noticed  in  the  same 
calendar.  The  earliest  mention  of  the 
festival  is  in  the  Bucherian  calendar,  where 
it  is  fixed  as  on  viii.  Cal.  Mart.  It  is  not 
mentioned  in  the  Gelasian  saeramentary,  or 
in  the  Ambrosian  liturgy  ;  but  the  majority 
of  calendars  and  martyrologists  notice  the 
two  festivals. — Patrol.  Ixxii.  181 ;  Ixxiv.  877  ; 
cxxi.  590 ;  Mabillon,  de  Liturgia  Qall.  lib. 
ii.  119. 

CATHEDRAL.  The  chief  church  in 
every  diocese  is  called  the  Cathedral,  from 
the  word  cathedra,  a  chair,  because  in  it  the 
bishop  has  his  seat  or  throne.  The  cathe- 
dral church  is  the  parish  church  of  the 
whole  diocese  (which  diocese  was  commonly 
called  parochia  in  ancient  times,  till  the 
application  of  this  name  to  the  lesser 
branches  into  which  it  was  divided,  caused 
it  for  distinction's  sake  to  be  called  only  by 
the  name  of  diocese).  It  was  not  called  the 
cathedral  church  till  the  tenth  century,  before 
which  the  term  ecclesia  matrix,  to  distinguish 
it  from  the  ordinary  churches,  or  ecclesia 
dioecesanx,  was  used.  In  it  the  bishop  was 
formally  enthroned,  and  ordinations  held; 
and  in  the  Celtic  and  Saxon  times  the 
manumission  of  serfs  took  place  before  the 
altar  of  the  cathedral. 

By  the  5th  canon  of  the  5th  Council  of 
Carthage  it  is  ordained  that  every  bishop 
shall  have  his  residence  at  his  principal  or 
cathedral  church,  which  he  shall  not  leave, 
to  betake  himself  to  any  other  church  in 
his  diocese ;  nor  continue  upon  his  private 
concerns,  to  the  neglect  of  his  cure,  and 
hindrance  of  his  frequenting  the  cathedral 
church. — Bingham. 

The  constitution  of  Archbishop  Langton 
(1222),   of  Otto   (1237),  and   of   Ottobon^ 


CATHEDKAL 

(1268),  enjoin  attendance  of  the  bishops  at 
their  cathedrals,  especially  in  Advent  and 
Lent.  By  the  canons  of  the  Church  of 
England  it  is  enjoined  that  "  in  all  cathedral 
and  coUegiate  churches,  the  holy  communion 
shall  he  administered  upon  principal  feast 
days,  sometimes  by  the  bishop  (if  he  be 
present)  and  sometimes  by  the  dean,  and 
sometimes  by  a  canon  or  prebendary ;  the 
principal  minister  using  a  decent  cope,  and 
being  assisted  with  the  gospeller  and  epistoler 
agreeably,  according  to  the  advertisements 
published  in  the  seventh  year  of  Queen 
Elizabeth.     (Canon  24.)     (See  below.) 

"Every  dean,  master,  or  warden,  or 
chief  governor  of  any  cathedral  or  col- 
legiate church,  shall  be  resident  there 
fourscore  and  ten  days,  conjunctim  or  di- 
visim,  in  every  year  at  the  least,  keeping 
good  hospitality,  and  preaching  in  their 
own  houses  as  often  as  they  are  bound 
by  law,  statute,  ordinance  or  custom :  and 
that  they  shall  suffer  no  stranger  to 
preach,  unless  by  leave  of  the  archbishop, 
bishop,  or  by  either  of  the  universities, 
and  no  strange  doctrine  to  be  published." 
(Canons  42,  43,  51.) 

"  Prebendaries  at  large  shall  not  be  absent 
from  their  cures  above  a  month  in  the 
year ;  and  residentiaries  shall  divide  the 
year  among  them;  and,  when  their  resi- 
dence is  over,  shall  repair  to  their  benefices." 
(Canon  44.) 

The  passage  of  the  advertisements  pub- 
lished in  the  seventh  year  of  Queen  Eliza- 
beth, referred  to  in  Canon  24,  is  as  follows  : 
"Item,  in  the  ministration  of  the  holy 
communion  in  cathedral  and  collegiate 
chtirches,  the  principal  minister  shall  use  a 
cope,  with  gospeller  and  epistoler  agreeably  ; 
and  at  all  other  prayers  to  be  said  at  the 
communion  table,  to  use  no  copes  but 
surplices.  Item,  that  the  dean  and  pre- 
bendaries wear  a  surplice,  with  a  silk  hood, 
in  the  choir ;  and  when  they  preach  in  the 
cathedral  or  collegiate  church,  to  wear  a 
hood."  (See  Advertisements.)  And  at  the 
end  of  the  service  book  in  the  second  year 
of  Edward  VI.,  it  is  ordered  that  "in  aU 
cathedral  churches,  the  archdeacons,  deans, 
and  prebendaries,  being  gradxiates,  may  use 
in  the  choir,  besides  their  surplices,  such 
hoods  as  pertaineth  to  their  several  degrees, 
which  they  have  taken  in  any  university 
within  this  realm." 

The  office  of  dean  is  of  comparatively 
late  date,  the  first  in  England  having  been 
the  dean  of  St.  Paul's  in  a.d.  1086.  (See 
Bean  and  Chapter;  Cathedral  Estahlish- 
ments.) 

Churches  collegiate  and  conventual  were 
always  visitable  by  the  bishop  of  the  dio- 
cese, if  no  special  exemption  was  made  by 
the  founder  thereof.    The  bishop's  right  to 


CATHEDRAL 


139 


visit  his  cathedral  church  was  frequently 
and  strenuously  opposed  in  England  before 
the  Reformation,  but  was  generally  main- 
tained. Archbishop  Laud  held  a  visitation 
(asarchbishop)of  St.  Paul's  Cathedral inl636, 
but  the  dean  and  chapter  protested  that  it 
was  contrary  to  all  precedent — of  course  in 
vain ;  but  the  claim  has  never  been  repeated 
anywhere,  and  there  is  no  authority  for  it, 
except  of  course  in  the  two  metropolitan 
dioceses.     (See  PhUlimore,  206.) 

CATHEDKAL  ESTABLISHMENTS. 
Cathedrals  are  divided  into  "Old"  and 
"New,"  but  the  new  comprise  those  of 
various  dates  and  constitutions.  The  old 
are  those  which  existed  as  cathedrals,  with 
deans  and  prebendaries,  before  the  confisca- 
tion of  the  monasteries,  the  churches  of 
which,  in  some  cases,  were  also  cathedrals 
or  the  seats  of  bishops,  and  were  refounded 
as  such  under  Henry  VIII.  Even  the  great 
churches  of  Canterbury,  Durham,  Ely,  and 
Winchester  were  so,  and  accordingly  rank 
as  New  cathedrals  together  with  Rochester, 
Norwich,  Carlisle  and  Worcester,  which 
eight  are  called  the  Conventual  Cathedrals, 
being  only  refounded  by  Henry  VIIL,  but 
bishoprics  long  before.  Those  of  the  old 
foundation  are  York,  London,  Lincoln,  Lich- 
field, Salisbury,  Exeter,  Wells,  Chichester, 
Hereford,  Bangor,  Llandaff,  St.  Asaph,  St. 
David's  (which  was  once  an  archbishopric — 
of  Menevia,  and  the  bishops  used  to  sign 
"  Menevensis ").  These  alone  have  pre- 
bendal  stalls,  though  now  robbed  of  their 
provender  by  the  Act  of  1840,  and  "  great 
chapters  "  as  distinguished  from  the  residen- 
tiary or  small  chapters.  The  other  cathedrals 
have  only  24  "  honorary  canons  "  besides  the 
residentiaries.  Five  sees  were  altogether 
founded  by  Henry  VIIL,  viz.  Chester,  Peter- 
borough, Gloucester,  Bristol,  and  Oxford, 
besides  Westminster  for  a  very  short  time, 
having  had  only  one  bishop,  Thirlby.  What 
may  be  called  the  very  new  cathedrals,  all 
of  this  reign,  are  Ripon  and  Manchester, 
which  were  converted  from  collegiate 
churches  like  Westminster  and  Windsor 
into  cathedrals,  the  former  in  1836,  the  latter 
in  1848;  St.  Alban's,  founded  in  1877 
under  an  Act  of  1875  ;  and  Truro  under  an 
Act  of  1876  ;  Liverpool  in  1880 ;  Newcastle, 
1882;  Southwell,  1884,  which  was  an  old, 
collegiate  church  before,  but  destroyed  a& 
such  in  1840 ;  and  Wakefield  not  yet :  the 
last  four  under  an  Act  for  them  of  1878. 
And  in  1884  was  passed  an  Act  for  sepa- 
rating Gloucester  and  Bristol  again,  which 
were  united  in  1840,  whenever  sufficient 
funds  are  raised.  None  since  1840  have  any 
dean  and  chapter,  but  have  honorary  canons ; 
and  as  no  adequate  chapter  endowments 
could  be  provided  for  less  than  £100,000' 
each,  and  nobody  knows   what   they   are- 


140 


CATHEDEAL 


wanted  for,  tlaey  are  likely  to  remain  so, 
•except  that  there  is  no  reason  why  the  re- 
spective rectors  should  not  be  called  deans. 

Most  of  the  old  cathedrals  have  a  dean, 
.sub-dean,  chancellor  (of  the  church,  not  of 
■the  diocese,  q.v.),  treasurer,  precentor ;  who 
are  generally,  but  not  always,  canons  resi- 
dentiary. At  York  sometimes  neither 
.chancellor,  sub-dean,  nor  precentor  are 
residentiaries,  and  there  is  no  treasurer. 
Sometimes  also  there  is  a  succentor.  In 
some  of  them,  the  minor  canons,  or  vicars 
choral,  clerical  and  lay,  are  a  separate 
corporation.  In  the  new  cathedrals  the 
precentor  is  generally  a  minor  canon.  Towns 
where  cathedrals  are  have  a  right  to  be 
called  cities.  Lord  Coke  said ;  but  that  right 
has  been  assumed  to  have  been  inadvertently 
taken  away  by  the  Mimicipal  Eeform  Act, 
183.7,  so  as  now  to  require  a  warrant  or 
letters  patent  from  the  Crown.  But  if  it 
really  was  taken  away  by  the  Act  of 
ParUament  naming  the  corporations  (not 
the  towns)  by  other  titles,  it  is  not  easy  to 
see  how  letters  patent  can  override  it,  and 
therefore  of  what  use  they  are. 

Cathedrals  or  their  chapters  are  governed 
by  statutes  of  their  own,  like  colleges,  which 
their  visitors,  i.e.  the  bishops,  used  to  vary 
from  time  to  time  with  the  consent  of  the 
whole  corporation.  (See  Cathedral  Com- 
missions.') The  new  cathedrals  of  Henry 
VIII.  had  statutes  given  by  him,  but  it 
was  doubtful  if  they  were  duly  made,  and 
by  1  Eliz.  c.  22,  power  was  given  to  her 
personally  to  make  statutes  through  royal 
commissioners :  which  it  seems  were  made 
"by  them  in  1572,  but  never  ratified  by  her ; 
and  by  6  Anne,  c.  21,  it  was  enacted  that 
in  all  cathedrals  founded  by  Henry  VIII. 
such  statutes  as  have  been  usually  received 
and  practised  since  the  Restoration,  and 
which  the  deans  and  canons  have  been  used 
to  swear  to  should  be  valid.  In  some  cases 
statutes  have  been  varied  by  special  Acts 
of  Parliament,  in  matters  considered  to 
be  beyond  the  power  of  a  visitor,  vidth 
the  concurrence  of  the  chapter.  In  Lich- 
field completely  new  statutes  have  been 
often  made  by  the  bishop  with  the  assent 
of  the  chapter.  Alterations  in  details  not 
inconsistent  with  the  general  law  have  been 
frequently  made  in  modem  times  by  the 
bishops  and  the  chapter  together ;  and  much 
larger  ones  in  old  times,  even  to  the  extent 
of  annexing  canonries  to  offices,  and  sus- 
pending them  altogether  to  apply  the 
proceeds  to  repairs  or  other  purposes":  which 
is  all  impossible  since  the  Act  of  3  &  4 
Vict.  c.  106. 

By  some  means  or  other,  bishops  have 
been  gradually  ousted  of  their  jurisdiction 
over  and  in  their  cathedrals  more  than  in 
all  the  other  churches  in  their  diocese.     In 


CATHEDEAL 

old  times  we  always  read  of  the  great 
works  in  cathedrals,  including  rebuilding, 
being  done  by  the  Ijishops.  Now  at  last 
it  has  come  to  be  held  that  not  even  the 
bishop's  licence  or  faculty  is  required  for 
any  cathedi'al  alteration  (in  the  Exeter 
reredos  case,  Philpotts  v.  Boyd,  7  P.  C.  435), 
and  consequently  that  he  has  no  power  to 
interfere,  except  by  visitation ;  and  then  only 
if  the  alteration  made  is  absolutely  illegal  in 
itself,  such  as  setting  up  a  crucifix  or  some- 
thing of  that  kind,  for  which  the  chapter 
maybe  prosecuted.  It  is  by  no  means  clear 
that  he  could  prevent  them  from  puUing 
down  half  the  cathedral,  if  they  could 
show  that  they  left  enough  for  performing 
divine  service.  Nor  has  he  any  means 
of  enforcing  a  right  to  preach,  except  on 
days  which  happen  to  be  assigned  to  him 
(if  any)  by  the  statutes;  or  to  use  the 
church  for  ordinations  or  any  other  diocesan 
purpose.  Probably  all  this  has  arisen  from 
the  very  fact  that  his  jurisdiction  was  so 
much  a  matter  of  course  in  pld  times  that  it 
was  thought  imnecessary  to  express  it  in 
cathedral  statutes.  (See  Cathedral  Com- 
missions.) 

By  the  Cathedral  Acts  Amendment  Act, 
1873,  the  Ecclesiastical  Commissioners  may 
accept  plans  for  re-endowing  any  "  sus- 
pended" canonry  or  founding  new  ones  and 
annexing  thereto  any  special  clerical  or  edu- 
cational duties,  and  making  the  tenure 
depend  on  their  performance.  One  such 
re-endowment  has  taken  place  in  St.  Paul's 
for  the  diocesan  inspector  of  church  schools. 
[G.] 

CATHEDRAL  ARCHITECTURE.  The 
normal  plan  of  an  English  cathedral  is  in 
the  form  of  a  Latin  cross ;  a  cross,  that 
is,  whose  transverse  arms  are  less  than  the 
lower  limb,  and  the  upper  smaller  still.  In 
a  general  architectural  description  its  parts 
are  sufficiently  distinguished  as  nave,  choir, 
and  transept,  with  their  aisles,  western 
towers,  and  central  tower ;  but  in  more 
minute  description,  especially  where  ritual 
arrangements  are  concemed,<'these  terms  are 
not  always  sufficiently  precise,  and  we  shall 
hardly  arrive  at  the  more  exact  nomencla- 
ture without  tracing  the  changes  in  a 
cathedral  church  from  the  Norman  period 
to  our  own. 

In  a  Norman  cathedral,  the  east  end,  or 
architectural  choir,  usually  terminated  in 
an  apse,  (see  Apse,)  which  was  surrounded 
by  the  continuation  of  the  choir  aisles,  often 
forming  a  path  for  processions  round  the 
back  of  the  altar,  which  was  called  the  pro- 
cessionary.  The  bishop's  throne  was  placed 
behind  the  altar,  and  the  altar  itself  in  the 
chord  of  the  apse ;  and  westward  of  this 
was  a  considerable  space,  unoccupied  in 
ordinary  cases,  which  was  called  the  pres- 


CATHEDKAL 


CATHEDKAL 


141 


hytery.  The  choir,  or  place  in  which  the 
daily  service  was  performed,  was  partly 
under  the  central  tower,  with  one  or  two  or 
three  bays  of  the  nave  in  addition,  as  it  is 
still  at  Westminster  and  some  others. 

In  the  transepts  and  aisles,  and  also  in 
the  crypt,  which  generally  extended  be- 
neath the  whole  eastern  limb  of  the  church, 
were  numerous  altars,  and  little  chapels 
were  often  thrown  out,  of  an  apsidal  form, 
for  other  altars.  One  chapel  especially  was 
dedicated  to  the  Blessed  Virgin,  and  called 
the  Lady  Chapel.  Its  place-was  not  constant, 
but  generally  it  was  a  lower  extension 
eastwards  from  the  choir.  The  most  notable 
exception  is  at  Ely,  where  it  is  north  of  the 
choir ;  and  it  once  was  at  Peterborough. 

Subsequent  churches  were  of  course 
subject  to  many  variations,  but  they  gene- 
rally followed  much  this  course.  First,  the 
apse  was  taken  down,  and  the  eastern  arm 
of  the  cross  was  extended  considerably,  so 
as  to  enlarge  the  presbytery,  or  part  in 
which  the  altar  stood,  and  to  add  a  retro- 
choir  in  place  of  the  old  processionary  be- 
hind it;  and  this  change  was  generally 
connected  in  prospect,  and  often  at  once, 
with  entirely  carrying  the  working  or  ritual 
choir  eastward  of  the  great  tower,  or,  in 
other  words,  reconciling  the  ritual  with  the 
architectural  arrangement.  After  this  yet 
another  addition  was  made  to  the  east  end, 
which  so  became  often  nearly  equal  to  the 
nave  in  length ;  and  the  JLady  Chapel  was 
built  beyond  the  presbytery  and  retrochoir. 
In  the  course  of  these  arrangements  the 
several  screens,  the  rood  screen  and  the 
altar  screen,'  had  to  be  removed.  The 
rood  screen  was  placed  under  the  eastern 
arch  of  the  tower,  which  may  be  called 
its  proper  place  wherever  the  church  has 
received  its  usual  additions.  This  screen 
was  often  a  wide  structure  and  became 
almost  universally  used  as  an  organ  loft ; 
and  though  the  organ  intercepts  the  view 
from  the  west  end  of  the  church,  it  is 
now  agreed,  after  trying  various  other 
places,  that  is  the  most  effective  place  for 
the  organ.  The  altar  screen  first  became 
necessary  at  the  enlarging  of  the  space  be- 
hind the  altar  :  it  formed  the  separation  of 
the  presbytery  from  the  retrochoir.  In 
some  instances  this  arrangement  has  been 
disturbed  in  modem  times,  but  always 
with  bad  effect,  and  the  old  one  has  been 
now  restored  everywhere. 

The  modifications  of  these  plans  and 
arrangements  are  various,  but  oftener  on 
the  side  of  excess  than  of  defect.  The 
great  transept  is  never  omitted  (Manchester 
can  hardly  be  called  an  exception,  since  it 
has  only  lately  been  made  a  cathedral) ; 
but  a  second  transept  to  the  east  of  the 
tower  was  often  added,  as  at  Canterbury, 


York,  Lincoln,  Salisbury,  Wells,  Worcester, 
Hereford,  Exeter  (low  ones),  Southwell, 
and  Beverley,  the  most  complete  church  in 
plan  in  the  kingdom,  having  both  a  great 
transept  with  double  aisles  and  a  smaller 
one  with  eastern  aisles,  and  proper  space- 
between  them,  which  Salisbury  wants  so 
much.  At  Durham  the  second  transept  is  at 
the  east  end  of  the  church,  which  it  crosses 
in  the  form  of  a  T.  Sometimes  there  was  a 
western  transept,  treated  in  the  same  way  as 
at  Ely  and  Peterborough ;  and  at  Durham, 
Ely,  and  Lincoln  is  another  considerable- 
addition,  called  the  Galilee,  which  at  Durham 
is  large  enough  for  a  separate  church ;  at 
Ely  it  is  a  large  western  porch,  and  at  Lincoln 
a  smaller  porch  west  of  the  south  transept. 
At  Canterbury  the  whole  arrangement  at 
the  east  is  very  remarkable,  the  crown 
of  Archbishop  Becket  taking  the  usual  place 
of  the  Lady  chapeL  The  shrines  of  reputed 
saints,  and  chantry  monuments  inserted  in 
different  portions  of  the  fabric,  with  little 
respect  for  its  general  efi'ect,  are  constant 
additions  to  the  plan ;  but  it  would  be  end- 
less to  enumerate  particular  cases. 

The  cathedrals  in  Ireland  were  always 
very  small.  That  of  Armagh,  the  largest, 
it  is  supjxjsed,  of  ancient  date,  and  originally 
built  by  St.  Patrick,  was  without  transepts, 
which  were  added  many  ages  after.  The 
most  interesting  relics  of  very  ancient  cathe- 
drals in  Ireland  are  at  Tuam  and  Clonfert. 

The  two  Dublin  cathedrals  were  restored 
a  little  before  the  Irish  Church  was  dis- 
established and  robbed ;  St.  Patrick's  at 
the  sole  cost  of  the  then  Mr.  Guinness,  the 
celebrated  brewer,  and  Christ  Church  by 
Mr.  Roe,  an  equally  eminent  distiller.  St.- 
Patrick's  is  only  as  large  as  some  of  the 
largest  English  parish  churches,  and  Christ 
Church  about  half  the  size.  The  Scotch 
cathedrals  were  also  very  small  compared 
with  ours,  but  some  of  them  of  much  finer 
architecture  than  any  in  Ireland,  which 
seems  to  have  been  very  poor  in  architecture 
always.  Glasgow  has  been  well  restored, 
and  contains  some  fine  features,  but  is  spoilt 
by  the  shortness  of  its  transepts.  St.  Giles's- 
so-called  cathedral  at  Edinburgh,  though  no 
bishop  sits  there,  which  had  become  divided 
into  several  churches  (all  Presbyterian),  has 
been  restored  to  its  proper  condition.  A 
new  cathedral,  called  St.  Mary's,  for  the 
episcopal  church  and  bishop  of  Edinburgh, 
was  founded  by  two  ladies  named  Paterson, 
and  was  one  of  Sir  Gilbert  Scott's  last 
works.  For  the  dimensions  of  all  these  we 
must  refer  to  the  list  at  the  end  of  Sir 
Edmund  Beckett's  book  on  Building,  and 
for  other  matters  to  Church  Architecture 
farther  on. 

Nearly  all  the  English  cathedrals  have 
been  more  or  less  restored  in  recent  times  - 


142 


CATHEDEAX, 


a  few,  and  si^ecially  Lichfield,  twice  over, 
in  conseq.uence  of  the  badness  of  the  first 
restoration  by  Wyatt.     In  some  of  them 
important  parts  have  been  entirely  rebuilt, 
generally  as  copies  or  supposed  copies  of 
the  original  work  of  some  Gothic  period, 
where  it  was  distinguishable.      The  most 
notable    case    of    adopting    a    later    style 
instead  of  the  earlier,  which  remained  in  a 
semi-ruinous  state,  is  at  Canterbury,  where 
the  Norman  N.W.  tower  was  pulled  down, 
in  the  time  of  many  people  now  living,  and 
rebuilt  as  a  copy  of  the  Perpendicular  S.W. 
one.    The  steeple  of  Chichester,  which  fell 
in  1862,  was  rebuilt  almost  exactly  as  it 
was  before,  only  with    the    tower  rather 
higher,  including  the  peculiar  shape  or  plan, 
which  is  not  square,  but  wider  from  E.  to 
W.  than  from  N.  to  S.     The  tower  of  St. 
Alban's  is  also  two  feet  wider  from  E.  to  W. 
The  tower  of  Bath  Abbey  is  much  more 
•oblong  the  other  way,  which  makes  it  look 
mean  and  narrow  in  all  the  long  or  N.  and  S. 
views  of  the  church,  while  the  smaller  sides 
of  Chichester  are  the  full  width   of  the 
cathedral  as  usual.     In  other  words,   Chi- 
chester and  St.  Alban's  are  widened,   but 
Bath  narrowed,  into  the  oblong  form.     The 
only  cathedrals  and    minsters    that    now 
have  western  towers  besides  a  central  one, 
however  low,  are  York,  Lincoln,  Durham, 
Canterbury,  AVestminster,  St.  Paul's,  Wells, 
Lichfield,  Beverley,  Southwell,  Peterborough 
(one),  and  the  one  great  mid- western  tower  of 
Ely,  which  Hereford  once  had.    The  central 
towers  of  Beverley  and  Westminster  only  just 
rise  above  the  roofs.  The  two  Exeter  Norman 
towers  are  at  the  ends  of  the  transepts,  and 
a,re  therein  unique,  and  they  were  originally 
towers  of  a  very  wide  west  front,  of  the 
nature  of  that  of  Wells,  where  alone  the 
towers  stand  outside  the  aisle,  and  yet  not 
far  enough;  for  they  appear  to  pinch  the 
west  parts  of    the  aisles  into    only  just 
enough  width  for  doorways.     Several  of  the 
greatest  abbeys  also  had  west  towers  beyond 
the  aisles,  as  Bury  and  St.  Alban's,  but  all 
of  them  vanished  long  ago :  indeed  nothing 
remains  of  that  great  church  of  Bury,  once 
the  largest  in  the  kingdom  except  old  St. 
Paul's,  which  was  much  longer  both  ways 
than  Wren's,  who  did  not  appreciate  the 
great  English  characteristic  of  length,  and 
had  the  highest  spire  in  the  world  besides. 
Coventry  cathedral,  with  .three  larger  spires 
than  Lichfield,  was  destroyed  by  Thomas 
Cromwell,  who  destroyed  far -more  churches 
than  Oliver.     The  nave  of  Bristol  had  been 
destroyed,  and  vanished  entirely,  but  the 
site  was  rescued  by  the  eiforts  of  Canon 
Norris,  and  a  new  nave  built  quite  recently. 
It  is  of  no  great  length,  and  it  will  be  much 
better  to  raise  the  present  low  and  dilapi- 
dated central  tower,  than  to  build  the  ugly 


CATHEDRAL 

west  ones  designed  by  the  late  Mr.  Street. 
St.  David's  and  Llandaff  have  also  been 
restored  from  a  condition  almost  worse  than 
destruction.  And  St.  Alban's  has  been 
saved  from  imminent  ruin  all  over.  First 
the  great  central  tower  was  on  the  point  of 
falling  like  that  of  Chichester,  and  one  of 
the  piers  had  to  be  almost  entirely  rebuilt, 
and  another  was  nearly  as  bad.  Then  the 
western  100  feet  of  the  south  clearstory, 
which  had  long  been  leaning  above  2  feet 
outwards,  showed  signs  of  falling,  and  had 
to  be  pumped  upright  by  hydraulic  pressure, 
and  in  a  great  measure  rebuilt  outside. 
Then  the  west  front,  which  had  been 
patched  up  several  times,  and  finally  with 
brick  walls,  increased  its  cracks  and  other 
symptoms  of  going.  Four  bays  of  the  north 
aisle  had  been  so  badly  rebuilt,  that  the 
wall  was  pushed  over  after  a  little  under- 
cutting. And  neither  they  nor  the  corre- 
sponding bays  of  the  south  wall  had  any 
windows.  All  the  roof  was  rotten,  and 
therefore  rebuilt  of  the  original  high  pitch. 
Five  pillars  of  the  nave,  and  those  the  five 
youngest,  of  the  Decorated  period,  were 
cracking  all  over,  and  had  to  be  almost 
rebuilt.  All  traces  of  the  original  west 
front,  including  the  faces  of  the  three 
porches,  had  so  completely  vanished  that 
any  pretence  of  "  restoring  "  it  must  have 
been  mere  invention,  and  indeed  impossible 
without  building  towers  also,  for  which  the 
original  front  was  at  any  rate  designed. 
Consequently  Sir  Edmund  Beckett,  who 
had  vmdertaken  the  work  of  restoration  by 
himself  in  1880,  designed  an  entirely  new 
front  of  the  style  to  which  most  of  the 
windows  of  the  church  belonged,  except 
those  of  the  clearstory,  restoring  as  much  of 
the  porches  as  was  possible,  exactly  like  the 
original  ones,  and  building  turrets  at  the 
angles  instead  of  towers.  Every  window 
in  the  nave  aisles  has  been  rebuilt,  wholly 
or  nearly,  and  eight  new  ones  added  in  the 
previously  dark  bays,  and  all  the  buttresses 
are  either  new  or  restored,  and  a  great 
deal  of  the  walls ;  and  the  aisles  re-roofed. 
That  cathedral  is  imique  in  its  materials, 
being  built  originally  of  large  flat  Koman 
bricks  of  the  adjacent  Verulamium,  even 
to  the  pillars,  which  are  plastered  with 
Norman  plaster,  except  those  which  were 
replaced  by  Early  English  and  Decorated 
ones.  Some  of  that  work  remains  outside 
mixed  with  flint  work,  in  which  much  of  the 
restoration  has  been  done  again.  Moreover, 
nearly  the  whole  church  inside  is,  and 
always  was,  plastered,  except  the  decorative 
parts :  which  is  a  decisive  rebuke  to  archi- 
tects who  go  about  destroying  the  plaster 
in  smaller.churches,  and  leaving  them  like 
a  wall  in  a  field,  and  worse  than  any 
cottage  back   kitchen.      External   plaster 


CATHEDRAL 

is  a  different  thing,  and  never  looks  well  or 
lasts  long.  The  Koman  bricks  and  great 
thickness  of  cement  (all  renewed)  give  a 
peculiar  and  pleasing  colour  to  the  great 
Norman  tower  of  that  unique  cathedral. 
The  transepts  are  in  equal  need  of  restora- 
tion, which  is  begun. 

The  two  greatest  restorations  yet  com- 
pleted, measuring  by  cost,  are  of  Worcester 
and  Chester  cathedrals.  The  latter, was 
decayed  many  inches  deep  all  over,  so  that 
the  stones  mostly  looked  more  like  boulders 
than  square-faced  and  moulded  ashlar,  and 
«very  bit  of  ornamental  work  had  gone. 
The  tower  of  Worcester  was  as  bad,  or  worse, 
for  all  the  ornamental  features  had  been 
deliberately  cut  off,  and  a  good  deal  of  the 
upper  part  v?as  only  brick  plastered.  It  is 
now  one  of  the  finest  Decorated  towers  in 
the  kingdom — perhaps  second  only  to  Lin- 
coln— which  was  done  at  the  cost  of  the 
late  Lord  Dudley.  Almost  the  whole  ex- 
ternal face  of  the  cathedral  has  been 
restored,  and  some  very  bad  modern  east 
and  west  windows  replaced  with  Early 
English  and  Decorated  ones ;  and  the  inside 
made  more  gorgeous  with  marble  and  gilding 
than  that  of  any  other  cathedral,  from  being 
about  the  shabbiest  both  inside  and  outside. 
The  taking  down  of  the  tower  of  Peter- 
borough in  1883  to  prevent  its  falling,  like 
several  others  from  original  bad  Norman 
building,  ought  to  be  recorded,  though  a 
grand  opportunity  of  restoring  it  like  the 
much  higher  original  Norman  was  missed 
because  a  majority  of  the  chapter,  against 
the  dean  and  the  architect,  and  a  majority 
of  3  to  1  of  the  subscription  committee, 
persisted  in  rebuilding  an  exact  copy  of  the 
accidental  mongrel  of  Norman  and  Decorated 
which  had  gro^vn  up  from  constructional 
•defects,  and  the  committee  were  weak  enough 
to  abdicate  their  power  to  an  external  arbi- 
trator who  sided  with  the  chapter.  It  must 
not  be  forgotten  too  that  first  the  choir  and 
then  the  nave  of  our  largest  cathedral, 
York,  were  burnt  down  within  eleven  years, 
the  last  in  1840,  and  had  to  be  rebuilt  at 
■enormous  cost,  the  vaulting  being  of  wood. 
The  Canterbury  choir  roof  was  set  on  fire 
by  plumbers,  but  as  there  was  a  stone  vault 
imdemeath  it  only  burnt  itself.  The  west 
front  of  Lichfield  had  been  hacked  to  pieces 
and  rebuilt  of  stucco  by  Wyatt,  the  fashion- 
able architect  of  a  century  ago,  and  the  de- 
"vastator  of  every  cathedral  he  was  allowed 
to  touch,  and  has  lately  been  restored  again 
to  stone  at  great  expense,  and  his  internal 
devastations  also  replaced  with  mostly  very 
good  work.  His  ruination  of  Salisbury  is 
beyond  restoration,  and  Scott's  attempts  at 
it  were  less  successful,  both  internal  and 
•external,  than  in  most  of  the  numerous 
cathedrals  and  churches  which  he  restored, 


OATHEDEAL 


143 


during  the  30  years  before  1878,  when  he 
died.  He  was  much  more  successful  in 
restoring  than  in  building,  for  he  had  the 
radical  defect  of  no  eye  for  proportions, 
especially  on  a  large  scale,  as  some  of  his 
works  show  lamentably. 

While  we  are  writing  there  is  a  call  for 
£80,000  to  restore  the  national  abbey  church 
of  Westminster,  which  is  said  to  have  be- 
come even  dangerous.  There  are  also  some 
very  ominous  looking  cracks  in  the  grandest 
of  all  towers,  Lincoln.  The  architectural 
peculiarities  of  all  the  cathedrals  are  ex- 
hibited in  so  many  books  that  we  need  not 
lengthen  this  article  by  describing  them. 
(See  Nave.)    [G.] 

CATHEDRAL  COMMISSIONS.  This 
subject  has  acquired  sufficient  importance  of 
late  for  a  separate  article.  What  was  called 
the  Church  Commission  of  1835  and  several 
years  early  in  this  reign,  and  produced  the 
great  Cathedral  Heform  Act  of  1840,  3  &  4 
Vict.  c.  113,  really  became  a  commission  for 
diverting  to  parochial  purposes  as  much  of 
cathedral,  and  afterwards  episcopal  revenues, 
as  the  commission  thought  fit.  And  un- 
doubtedly there  was  much  truth  in  Sydney's 
remark,  that  the  author  of  it  all,  Bishop 
Blomfield  of  London,  had  become  "  the 
Church  of  England  here  upon  earth."  Lord 
Russell,  who  was  himself  one  of  those  com- 
missioners, said  long  afterwards,  that  he 
thought  they  had  done  too  much,  but  that 
it  was  all  Bishop  Blomfield's  doing. 

What  they  and  the  Act  did  was  sub- 
stantially this.  They  intended  at  first,  and 
the  bill  was  so  brought  in,  to  abolish  all  the 
canonries  and  prebendaries  in  England  and 
Wales,  after  the  deaths  of  the  existing 
holders,  except  four  canons  residentiary  in 
each  cathedral  and  collegiate  church,  and 
two  or  three  more  in  a  few  special  cases, 
and  abolishing  all  in  the  collegiate  churches 
except  Westminster,  Windsor,  Manchester, 
and  Ripon ;  of  which  the  two  last  were  to 
be  made  cathedrals  with  the  usual  establish- 
ment. During  its  progress  through  Parlia- 
ment abolition  was  altered  into  what  was 
called  "  suspension ''  of  the  endowments  of 
all  those  prebends,  and  the  bishops  were 
authorised  to  appoint  twenty-four  "  honorary 
canons  "  in  all  the  "  new  cathedrals,"  (which 
had  only  residentiaries  before,)  with  stalls 
therein,  but  no  other  rights.  But  the  Act 
reserved  to  those  in  the  old  cathedrals  all 
their  rights  except  to  any  endowment, 
which  means  the  right  of  voting  for  whatever 
has  to  be  done  by  the  "greater  chapter" 
and  not  by  the  residentiaries  alone,  which 
differs  in  different  cathedrals.  Nor  was  that 
all  the  confiscation  effected.  There  were 
generally  separate  endowments  of  each 
canonry,  besides  an  aliquot  proportion  of 
the  corpus  of  the  capitular  estates,  of  which 


Ui 


CATHEDKAL 


the  dean  usually  had  two  shares  and  each 
canon  one.  The  commission  chose  to  take 
away  all  the  separate  endowments,  including 
all  their  separate  patronage,  and  that  of  every 
diocesan  official,  and  all  share  of  the  general 
ones  too  which  would  leave  a  dean  more 
than  £2000  a  year  (except  two  of  them), 
and  the  canons  £1000,  and  the  bishops 
took  all  that  patronage  for  themselves.  But 
when  they  came  to  "level  upwards"  hy 
redistribution  they  only  levelled  deans  up 
to  £1000  it  year — after  taking  away  all 
their  separate  property  too — and  canons  to 
£500.  'I'he  otherwise  poor  deanery  of  Lich- 
field had  been  endowed  by  a  special  Act 
with  a  living  a  few  miles  off,  and  even  that 
was  afterwards  taken  away  and  given  to  the 
Crown  by  another  special  Act;  and  the 
Dean  of  Wells  was  deprived  by  a  Crown 
lawsuit  of  another  in  that  city,  because 
its  gross  income  was  above  £500  a  year, 
though  the  net  income  was  below  it.  And 
yet  further  still,  when  an  attempt  was 
made  at  a  late  stage  of  the  bill  to  rescue  the 
trifling  amount  of  £20  a  year  as  payment  to 
the  "rifled  canons"  for  their  expenses  of 
institution  and  coming  to  preach  and  attend 
chapters,  it  was  resisted  by  the  author  of  all 
this  "  holy  innovation,"  as  he  called  it,  and 
defeated.  Their  dealing  with  the  episcopal 
estates  does  not  belong  to  this  article.  AH 
the  estates  and  funds  thus  obtained  were  to 
be  and  have  been  ever  since  administered 
by  the  then-estabhshed  Ecclesiastical  Com- 
mission for  parochial  purposes,  and  of  course 
have  been  enormously  beneficial  in  that 
way. 

Some  years  after  these  reforms  had  begun 
to  operate  on  new  deans  and  canons,  the 
gross  inadequacy  of  the  smaller  deaneries 
lor  the  duties  and  the  houses  of  the  deans 
had  induced  the  Ecclesiastical  Commission 
to  raise  one  of  them  to  the  sum  below 
which  none  were  to  be  reduced  by  Bishop 
Blomfield's  commission,  except  by  taking 
their  separate  estates ;  and  another  with 
one  of  the  largest  houses  was  all  but  raised 
too  when  the  chairman  of  the  Ecclesiastical 
Commission  objected  to  it,  and  an  opinion 
■was  given  by  the  Attorney-General  that 
they  had  no  power  to  do  it,  and  so  the 
improvement  of  the  poor  deaneries  was 
stopped.  If  he  was  right,  the  power  ought 
to  have  been  got  at  once ;  and  now  that 
deans  are  prohibited  from  holding  any 
extra-mural  living,  by  13  &  14  Vict.  c.  94, 
s.  19,  and  there  is  a  tendency  to  require 
such  residence  both  of  deans  and  canons 
as  will  allow  them  to  hold  no  other 
preferment,  it  is  evident  that  either  the 
poor  ones  must  be  augmented  or  the  chapters 
wiU  he  filled  with  a  lower  class  of  men,  or 
accidental  rich  ones,  if  such  are  to  be  found, 
whether  fit  or  not. 


CATHEDRAL 

The  next  commission  was  in  1852,  "to 
inquire  into  the  state  of  the  cathedrals  and 
collegiate  churches  .  .  .  with  a  view  to 
rendering  the  same  more  efBcient "  (we  omit 
a  heap  of  superfluous  words),  "  with  a  view 
to  the  suggestion  of  such  measures  as  may 
make  them  available  in  aid  of  the  erection 
of  new  sees,  or  of  other  arrangements  for  the 
discharge  of  episcopal  duties ;"  which  last 
words  have  been  utterly  disregarded  in 
founding  all  the  subsequent  new  sees,  with 
an  absolute  prohibition  of  applying  any  of 
the  Ecclesiastical  Commission  funds  in  aid 
of  them,  even  to  secure  bishops'  residences. 
It  is  important  now  to  contrast  the  class  of 
commissioners  then  and  always  previously 
appointed,  with  those  whom  it  has  become 
the  fashion  to  appoint  in  later  times  to 
revise  the  Church  of  England,  its  courts- 
and  its  cathedrals.  They  were  the  two 
archbishops,  the  Bishop  of  London  and 
"S.  Oxon,"  the  then  Dean  of  Arches,  Sir  John, 
Patteson,  and  Sir  W.  P.  Wood,  Christopher 
Wordsworth,  afterwards  bishop,  Dr.  Hook,, 
then  perhaps  the  most  distinguished  of 
parochial  clergymen,  though  not  yet  a  dean, 
J.  Jackson,  afterwards  bishop  of  London,, 
and  M.  Villiers,  afterwards  bishop,  and. 
WiUiam  Selwyn,  Canon  of  Ely  and  Mar- 
garet Professor  of  Divinity  at  Cambridge, 
who  had  the  chief  hand  in  saving  the 
canonries  in  1840  from  entire  destruction. 
They  sat  for  two  years  and  made  several 
reports,  which  fill  about  900  pages  of  blue 
books  closely  printed  with  cathedral  statutes 
and  statistics.  Their  most  important  state- 
ments and  recommendations  were  as  follows. 
They  describe  the  early  history  and  state  of 
the  cathedrals,  saying  particularly  that  the 
bishop  when  present  had  an  assigned  part 
in  the  services,  that  he  presided  over  the 
whole  body,  and  made  regulations  with  their 
advice.  "  In  the  conventual  cathedrals  (of 
Henry  VIII.)  it  is  declared  that  the  dean, 
and  prebendaries  shall  be  incorporated  and 
united  with  the  bishop  for  all  future  time ; 
and  in  the  new  ones  the  chapter  is  declared 
to  consist  of  the  bishop,  dean  and  pre- 
bendaries ;  and  there  is  no  definition  of  the 
bishop's  rights,  except  as  visitor."  Also, 
that  the  archdeacons  had  a  place  in  the 
choir  and  a  voice  in  chapter  (which  has  long^ 
been  silent  unless  they  happen  to  be  canons) ; 
that  the  cathedral  was  the  parish  church  of" 
the  diocese ;  that  the  chapter  was  the  bishop's 
council  of  advice  in  all  weightier  causes- 
(which  is  quite  contrary  to  the  modem  idea 
that  they  have  as  little  to  do  with  each, 
other  as  possible).  "We  have  shown  in 
our  first  report  that  the  connection  between, 
the  bishop  and  the  cathedral  has  been  very 
much  impaired  by  a  variety  of  causes."' 
They  were  advised  that  both  in  the  old  ani 
new  cathedrals  no  power  remains  either  in 


CATHEDRAL 

the  king  or  the  visitor  to  make  new  statutes, 
though  it  existed  originally  and  was  often 
used.  The  latest  commission  report  how- 
ever shows  that  the  contrary  view  of  the,  law 
has  always  been  acted  on  in  at  least  one 
cathedral,  Lichfield,  where  many  successive 
bishops,  up  to  the  present  time,  have  made 
new  statutes  with  the  assent  of  the  chapter ; 
and  the  same  was  done  at  York  and  London 
in  old  times  though  not  lately.  And  as 
the  Crown  or  the  visitor  generally  can — 
or  could  till  lately — alter  statutes  of  eccle- 
siastical and  eleemosynary  corporations 
with  their  consent,  it  seems  odd  that  the 
power  should  have  been  lost  in  the  cathe- 
drals, except  by  some  legislative  blundering. 
Their  main  recommendation,  which  in  fact 
superseded  all  the  others,  was  that  a  now 
cathedral  commission  should  be  appointed 
by  Act  of  Parhament  for  ten  years,  con- 
sisting of  the  archbishof)  and  two  bishops  of 
each  province,  one  dean  and  three  other 
persons  to  be  nominated  by  the  Crown, 
being  members  of  the  Church  of  England, 
and  that  each  chapter  be  required  to  prepare 
a  draft  of  new  or  amended  statutes  to  be 
approved  by  their  visitor,  and  then  laid 
liefore  the  commission  for  revision ;  or  in 
default,  that  the  commission  should  make 
them ;  and  that  after  the  expiration  of  that 
commission  further  alterations  might  be 
made  from  time  to  time  by  the  chapters 
with  the  approval  of  their  visitor,  and  the 
archbishop  and  the  Crown :  which  all  seems 
very  reasonable.  The  only  one  of  their 
recommendations  in  detail  that  need  be 
noticed  is  that  they  advised  exactly  the 
contrary  of  the  course  that  has  been  taken 
about  new  bishoprics.  They  say, "  Inasmuch 
as  the  Ecclesiastical  Commission  have  al- 
ready (and  will  have  more)  a  large  surplus 
from  the  episcopal  estates,  and  it  was  under- 
stood when  their  fusion  with  the  'common 
fund '  was  enacted,  that  the  obligation  to  pro- 
vide for  the  endowment  of  additional  sees  from 
the  surplus  of  the  episcopal  fund  was  not 
thereby  diminished,  the  Crown  should  be 
authorised  by  an  Act  like  31  Hen.  VIII. 
c.  9,  to  divide  dioceses,  and  that  the  requisite 
funds  should  be  provided  partly  by  local 
contributions  or  out  of  episcopal  property  in 
the  hands  of  the  commission : "  which  was  not 
only  disregarded  but  absolutely  prohibited 
by  a  clause  introduced  into  all  the  new 
bishopric  Acts,  it  is  believed,  by  some  of 
the  bishops  themselves,  with  the  idea  of 
making  the  scheme  popular.  One  of  their 
recommendations,  and  only  one,  was  adopted 
by  the  Bishops'  Resignation  Act,  1869,  viz. 
to  enable  coadjutor  bishops  to  be  appointed 
to  assist  disabled  ones,  with  the  right  of 
succession.  But  infirm  bishops  have  always 
hitherto  resigned  on  a  pension  instead  of 
accepting  coadjutors. 


CATHEDEAL 


145 


Nothing  else  came  of  that  commission, 
notwithstanding  the  unusual  experience  and 
ability  of  its  members,  and  the  completeness 
of  their  investigations.  Indeed  their  work 
seems  to  have  been  utterly  forgotten,  if 
ever  known,  by  the  Prime  Minister  of  1879, 
for  he  thought  fit  to  issue  a  new  royal 
commission  to  do  exactly  the  same  work 
over  again  without  the  least  reference  to  it ; 
and  they  chose  to  do  a  great  deal  more 
besides.  So  far  from  their  being  authorised 
to  propose  new  statutes,  they  were  to  report 
whether  in  their  opinion  such  power  should 
be  given  to  some  authority  by  legislation, 
and  if  so,  to  what.  It  is  worth  while 
to  contrast  both  the  names  of  the  com- 
missioners of  1852  and  the  future  ones 
proposed  by  them,  with  those  of  1879. 
The  former  consisted  of  both  archbishops 
and  two  principal  bishops,  and  three  subse- 
quent ones,  three  great  judges,  and  two  very 
distinguished  ecclesiastics,  and  for  the  future 
a  dean  and  three  other  nominees  of  the 
Crown :  the  latter,  of  only  one  archbishop 
(who  died  and  was  not  replaced)  and  one 
bishop,  one  Chief  Justice,  who  soon  resigned, 
and  one  Queen's  Counsel  of  no  ecclesiastical 
experience  who  also  died ;  the  dean  and  one 
canon  for  each  cathedral  to  be  operated  on, 
excluding  the  bishop  even  where  he  was 
also  metropolitan ;  Lord  Cranbrook,  Mr. 
Beresford  Hope,  and  Mr.  Charles  Dalrymple ; 
to  whom  the  next  Prime  Minister  added 
Lord  Blachford,  and  Sir  Walter  James,  which 
two  last  he  also  put  on  the  Ecclesiastical 
Courts  Commission. 

They  at  once  set  to  work,  without  the  least 
authority,  to  invent  new  statutes  for  every 
cathedral,  and  therewith  advised  that  an  Act 
should  be  passed  to  establish  a  committee  of 
the  Privy  Council "  to  approve,  and  if  they  see 
fit  amend  them . . .  and  that  they  should  then 
have  the  force  of  law."  Such  a  bill  was  ac- 
cordingly brought  in  by  one  of  the  members 
of  the  commission  and  passed  the  House  of 
Lords  twice,  but  got  no  farther.  Though 
they  seem  to  have  consulted  not  a  single 
bishop,  where  there  is  a  dean,  about  the 
statutes  of  his  own  cathedral,  which  in  old 
times  he  always  had  a  hand  in  making,  they 
published  some  correspondence  with  several, 
and  also  from  several  of  the  deans  on  the 
vexata  qusestio  of  the  relations  between 
them  and  the  bishops ;  which  the  1854  com- 
mission said  had  somehow  got  completely 
altered,  and  the  bishops  made  to  understand 
that  they  had  no  rights  in  their  cathedrals 
but  to  sit  in  the  throne  ruling  nothing,  and 
to  visit  them  every  three  or  four  years,  which 
practically  means  nothing.  The  most  striking 
thing  on  that  point  is  the  amazing  difference 
between  the  proposed  position  of  the  bishop  in 
the  only  cathedral  where  he  sat  as  dean  on  the 
commission,  because  there  is  none  (nor  indeed 


14G 


CATHOLIC 


any  actual  chapter,  only  a  contingent  one), 
and  all  the  others,  where  the  deans  sat  and 
acted  fur  themselves. 

In  sundry  points  their  proposed  statutes  are 
contrary  to  the  general  law  of  the  realm  as 
well  as  to  the  several  old  cathedral  statutes. 
But  we  cannot  afford  more  space  to  what 
are  mere  proposals.     [G.] 

CATHOLIC.  {Koff  S\ov.)  Universal  or 
general.  "  The  Church,"  says  St.  Cyril, "  is 
called  catholic,  because  it  is  throughout  the 
world,  from  one  end  of  the  earth  to  the 
other;  and  because  it  teaches  universally 
and  completely  all  the  truths  which  ought 
to  come  to  men's  knowledge,  concerning 
things  both  visible  and  invisible,  heavenly 
and  earthly ;  and  because  it  subjugates,  in 
order  to  godliness,  evorj'  class  of  men, 
governors  and  governed,  learned  and  un- 
learned; and  because  it  universally  treats 
and  heals  every  sort  of  sins  which  are  com- 
mitted by  soul  or  body,  and  possesses  in 
itself  every  form  of  virtue  which  is  named, 
both  in  deeds  and  words,  and  every  kind 
of  spiritual  gifts." — Catechetical  Lectures, 
xviii.  23. 

The  term  was  first  applied  to  the  Chris- 
tian Church  to  distinguish  it  from  the 
Jewish,  the  latter  being  confined  to  a  single 
nation,  the  former  being  open  to  all  who 
should  seek  admission  into  it  by  holy  bap- 
tism. Hence,  the  Christian  Church  is 
general  or  universal.  The  first  regularly 
organised  Christian  Church  was  formed  at 
Jerusalem.  When  St.  Peter  converted 
three  thousand  souls  (Acts  ii.  41),  the  new 
converts  were  not  formed  into  a  new  Church, 
but  were  added  to  the  original  society. 
When  Churches  were  formed  afterwards  at 
Samaria,  Antioch,  and  other  places,  these 
were  not  looked  upon  as  entirely  separate 
bodies,  but  as  branches  of  the  one  holy 
Catholic  or  Apostolic  Church.  St.  Paul 
says  (1  Cor.  xii.  13),  "  By  one  Spirit  we 
are  all  baptized  into  one  hody ;  "  and  (Eph. 
iv.  4),  "  There  is  one  body  and  one  Spirit." 
A  Catholic  Church  means  a  branch  of  this 
one  great  society,  as  the  Church  of  England 
is  said  to  be  a  Catholic  Chm'ch ;  the  Catho- 
lic Church  includes  all  the  Churches  in  the 
world  under  their  legitimate  bishops. 

When  in  after-times  teachers  began  to 
form  separate  societies,  they  frequently 
called  them  by  their  own  name.  Thus  the 
Arians  were  named  from  Arius,  the  Mace- 
donians from  Macedonius;  and,  in  later 
times,  Calvinists  from  Calvin,  and 
Wesleyans  from  Wesley.  But  the  true 
churchmen,  refusing  to  be  designated  by 
the  name  of  any  human  leader,  called 
themselves  Catholics,  i.e.  members,  not  of 
any  peculiar  society,  but  of  the  Universal 
Church.  And  the  term  thus  used  not  only 
distinguished  the  Church  from  the  world. 


CELESTINES 

but  the  true  Church  from  heretical  and 
schismatical  parties.  Hence,  in  ecclesi- 
astical history,  the  word  catholic  means  the 
same  as  orthodox,  and  a  catholic  Christian 
denotes  an  orthodox  Christian. 

At  some  times  a  portion  or  section  of 
Christians  have  called  themselves  or  have 
been  called  "  Catholics,"  as  with  regard  to 
those  who  receive  the  decrees  of  the  Council 
of  Trent.  But  though  Tridentines  or 
Eomanists  may  be  called  members  of  the 
Catholic  Church,  to  call  them  exclusively 
"Catholics,"  would  be  to  call  all  others 
"  heretics." 

The  word  is  also  used  as  applied  to  faith 
and  to  religion  (Athan.  Creed),  and  in  later 
times  in  a  much  restricted  sense,  as  dis- 
tinguishing a  church  from  an  oratory,  a 
parish  church  from  a  monastic  church. — 
Cone.  Trull.,  Can.  lix. ;  Du  Gauge ;  cf.  Epi- 
phan.  Hxr.  lix.  1. 

CATHOLIC  EPISTLES.  The  Epistles 
of  St.  James,  St.  Peter,  St.  Jude,  and  St. 
John  are  called  Catholic  Epistles,  either 
because  they  were  not  written  to  any  par- 
ticular person,  or  Church,  but  to  Christians 
in  general,  or  to  Christians  of  several  coun- 
tries :  or  because,  whatever  doubts  may  at 
first  have  been  entertained  respecting  some 
of  them,  they  were  all  acknowledged  by 
the  Catholic  or  Universal  Church,  at  the 
time  this  appellation  was  attached  to  them, 
which  we  find  to  have  been  common  in  the 
fourth  century. 

CAUTELiE  MISS.E.  The  shortened 
final  rubrics  which  in  1552  superseded 
those  which  had  been  placed  at  the  end  of 
the  Holy  Communion  office  in  1549.  The 
orders  for  "  unleavened  bread,"  the  reception 
of  the  bread  in  the  mouth,  and  not  in  the 
hand,  &c.,  were  omitted. 

CEALCHYTHE  (or  CALCHU- 
THEUSB),  Councils  of:  held  somewhere 
in  Mercia — probably  at  Chelsea  (Chelchett). 
Their  objects  were,  at  different  times,  to 
increase  the  amity  between  England  and 
Bome;  and  to  make  grants  to  different 
Churches. — Haddan  and  Stubbs,  iii.  444, 
478,  &c. 

CAVEAT.  A  caveat  is  a  caution  entered 
in  the  spiritual  court  (now  the  probate 
and  divorce  court)  to  stop  probates, 
administrations,  licences,  &c.,  from  being 
granted  without  the  knowledge  of  the  party 
that  enters  the  caveat. 

CELESTINES.  A  religious  order  of 
Chiistians,  which  derives  its  name  from  its 
founder,  Pietro  de  Morone,  afterwards 
Celestin  V.,  a  hermit,  who  followed  the 
rules  of  St.  Benedict,  who  founded  the  order 
in  1254,  and  got  the  institution  confirmed 
by  Pope  Urban  VIIL  in  1264,  and  by 
Gregory  X.  in  1273,  at  the  second  general 
Council  of  Lyons  :  this  order  soon  multiplied 


CELIBACY 

in  Italy,  and  was  brought  into  France  in 
1300,  by  Philip  the  Fair,  who  gave  them 
two  monasteries,  one  in  the  forest  of  Orleans, 
at  a  place  called  Ambert,  and  the  other  in 
ihe  forest  of  Compiegne,  in  Mount  Chartres. 
Charles,  dauphin  and  regent  of  France,  in 
1352,  wliile  King  John,  his  father,  was 
prisoner  in  England,  sent  for  six  of  these 
monks  of  Mount  Chartres,  to  establish  them 
at  Paris,  at  a  place  called  Barrez,  in  which 
ithey  were  confirmed  by  King  John,  and 
where  there  was,  till  the  Revolution,  a 
monastery  of  that  order.  The  Celestines 
were  called  hermits  of  St.  Damian  before 
their  institutor  became  pope.  Their  first 
monastery  was  at  Monte  Majella,  in  the 
kingdom  of  Naples. 

CELIBACY.  The  state  of  unmarried 
persons  :  a  word  used  chiefly  in  speaking  of 
the  single  life  of  the  Romish  clergy,  or  the 
■obligation  they  are  under  to  abstain  from 
marriage. 

At  the  time  of  the  Reformation,  scarcely 
any  point  was  more  canvassed  than  the 
right  of  the  clergy  to  marry.  The  celibacy 
•of  the  clergy  was  justly  considered  as  a 
principal  cause  of  irregular  and  dissolute 
living;  and  the  wisest  of  the  Reformers 
were  exceedingly  anxious  to  abolish  a  prac- 
tice, which  had  been  injurious  to  the 
interests  of  religion,  by  its  tendency  to 
corrupt  the  morals  of  those  who  ought  to 
•be  examples  of  virtue  to  the  rest  of  man- 
kind. The  marriage  of  priests  was  so  far 
from  being  forbidden  by  the  Mosaic  institu- 
tion, that  the  priesthood  was  confined  to 
tlie  descendants  of  one  family,  and  con- 
sequently there  was  not  only  a  permission, 
but  an  obligation  upon  the  Jewish  priests 
to  marry.  Hence  we  conclude  that  there  is 
Jio  natural  inconsistency,  or  even  unsuitable- 
ness,  between  the  married  state  and  the 
<luties  of  the  ministers  of  religion,  i^ot  a 
single  text  in  the  New  Testament  can  be 
interpreted  into  a  prohibition  against  the 
marriage  of  the  clergy  under  the  gospel 
dispensation;  but,  on  the  contrary,  there 
are  many  passages  from  which  we  may 
infer  that  they  are  allowed  the  same  liberty 
upon  this  subject  as  other  men  enjoy.  One 
of  the  twelve  apostles,  namely,  St.  Peter, 
was  certainly  a  married  man  (Matt.  viii. 
14) :  and  it  is  supposed  that  several  of  the 
others  were  also  married.  Phihp,  one  of 
the  seven  deacons,  was  also  a  married  man 
(Acts  xxi.  9) ;  and  if  our  Lord  did  not 
require  celibacy  in  the  first  preachers  of  the 
gospel,  it  cannot  be  thought  indispensable 
dn  their  successors.  St.  Paul  says,  "Let 
every  man  have  his  own  wife  "  (1  Cor.  vii. 
2) ;  and  the  writer  of  the  Epistle  to  the 
Hebrews,  that  marriage  is  honourable  in  all 
(xiii.  4),  without  excepting  those  who  are 
.employed  in  the  public  offices  of  religion. 


CELIBACY 


147 


St.  Paul  expressly  says,  that  "a  bishop 
must  be  the  husband  of  one  wife  "  (1  Tim. 
iii.  2);  and  he  gives  the  same  direction 
concerning  elders,  priests,  and  deacons. 
When  Aquila  travelled  about  to  preach  the 
gospel,  he  was  not  only  married,  but  his 
wife  Priscilla  accompanied  him  (Acts  xviii. 
2) ;  and  St.  Paul  insists  that  he  might  have 
claimed  the  privilege  "  of  carrying  about  a 
sister  or  wife  (1  Cor.  ix.  5),  as  other 
apostles  did."  Though  he  says  to  the  un- 
married, "  It  is  good  for  thee  to  abide  even 
as  I "  (1  Cor.  vii.),  yet  the  "  forbidding  to 
marry  "  (1  Tim.  iv.  3)  is  mentioned  as  a 
character  of  the  apostasy  of  the  latter  times. 
That  the  ministers  of  the  gospel  were  al- 
lowed to  marry  for  several  centuries  after 
the  days  of  the  apostles  appears  certain. 
Polycarp  (Mp.  ad  Philip,  n.  11)  mentions 
Valens,  presbyter  of  Philippi,  who  was  a 
married  man,  and  there  are  now  extant  two 
letters  of  Tertullian,  a  presbyter  of  the 
second  century,  addressed  to  his  wife. 
Novatus  was  a  married  presbyter  of  Carthage 
as  we  learn  from  Cyprian  {Ep.  49,  dl.  52, 
ad  Cornel.),  who  was,  in  the  opinion  of  some 
historians,  himself  a  married  man  (JPagi 
Grit,  in  Baron,  ad  an.  248) ;  and  so  was 
Cajcilius,  the  presbyter  who  converted  him, 
and  Numidicus,  another  presbyter  of  Car- 
thage ;  and  many  other  instances  might  be 
given.  In  the  Council  of  Nice,  a.d.  325,  a 
motion  was  made,  that  a  law  might  pass  to 
obUge  the  clergy,  if  married,  to  abstain  from, 
all  conjugal  society,  a  rule  wliich  had  been 
already  enjoined  by  the  Council  of  Elvira  in 
305 ;  but  it  was  strenuously  opposed  by 
Paphnutius,  a  famous  Egyptian  bishop,  who, 
although  himself  unmarried,  pleaded  that 
marriage  was  honourable,  and  that  so  heavy 
a  burden  as  abstaining  from  it  ought  not  to 
be  laid  upon  the  clergy.  Upon  which  the 
motion  was  laid  aside,  and  every  man  left  to 
his  liberty,  as  before.  (Socrat.  lib.  i.  c.  11 ; 
Sozom.  hb.  i.  c.  23.)  All  that  Valesius,  after 
Bellarmine,  has  to  say  agamst  this  is,  that 
he  suspects  the  truth  of  the  thing,  and  begs 
leave  to  dissent  from  the  historian.  (Vales, 
not.  in  Socrat.  as  above.)  There  seems,  how- 
ever, no  question  but  that  the  Cotmcil  of 
Nice  decreed  in  favour  of  the  married  clergy. 
(Du  Pin,  Bihlio.  vol.  ii.  p.  253,  ed.  Anglic. ; 
Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  390.)  The  same  thing 
is  evident  from  other  councils  of  the  same 
age ;  as  the  Councils  of  Grangra,  Ancyra, 
NeocKsarea,  Eliberis,  and  TruUo.  We  have 
also  a  letter  from  Hilary  of  Poitiers,  written 
to  his  daughter  when  he  was  in  exile ;  and 
from  what,  can  be  collected  concerning  her 
age,  it  seems  probable  that  she  was  born 
when  he  was  a  bishop.  At  the  same  time 
it  must  be  owned,  that  many  things  are 
said  in  praise  of  a  single  life  in  the  writings 
of   the  ancient   fethers;     and   the  law   of 

i  2 


148 


CELEBRANT 


celibacy  had  been  by  some  proposed,  before 
or  about  the  beginning  of  the  fourth  century. 

In  the  Eastern  Church  the  rule  which 
still  exists  was  established,  that  men  who 
were  married  before  ordination  might  con- 
tinue to  live  with  their  wives  (Socrat.  lib.  v. 
c.  22),  though  afterwards  a  difference  was 
made  between  bishops  and  presbyters  the 
■wives  of  the  fonner  being  ordered  to  retire 
to  a  convent.  {Cone.  Tridlo,  cc.  13,  48.) 
In  the  West  more  stringent  rules  were  made 
at  an  early  period.  At  the  Council  of  Elvira 
(a.d.  305)  the  idea  of  living  "as  brother- 
and-sister"had  been  put  forward,  but  Siricius, 
who,  according  to  Dufresnoy,  died  in  the 
year  399,  [397,  Baronius,]  was  the  first  pope 
who  forbade  the  marriage  of  the  clergy,  and 
several  councils,  more  especially  the  eighth 
and  ninth  of  Toledo,  653  and  659,  renewed 
the  prohibition :  but  the  celibacy  of  the 
clergy  seems  not  to  have  been  completely 
established  till  the  papacy  of  Gregory  VII., 
at  the  end  of  the  eleventh  century,  and  even 
at  that  time  it  was  loudly  complained  of  by 
many  writers.  The  history  of  the  following 
centuries  abundantly  proves  the  bad  effects 
of  this  abuse  of  Church  power.  The  old 
English  and  Welsh  records  show  that  the 
clergy  were  married  as  late  as  the  eleventh 
century.  The  rule  of  celibacy,  which  was 
but  indifferently  kept,  was  abolished  in 
England  in  1549.— Hume,  Ed.  VI.  c.  1 ; 
Bingham,  Ant,  bk.  iv.  c.  v. ;  Liber  Landa- 
vensis,  passim.  The  original  of  this  is  at 
Owston,  Doncaster, — the  property  of  Davies 
Cooke,  Esq. ;  it  was  originally  the  property 
of  Llandaff  cathedral. — Bid.  Oirist.  Ant. 
(Murray),  vol.  i.  323. 

CELEBRANT.  The  priest  who  cele- 
brates (or  administers)  the  Holy  Communion. 
For  dress  of  celebrants  see  Vestments ;  for 
his  position  at  the  holy  table  see  North 
Side. 

CELLA,  or  CELLA  MEMORIAL.  A 
small  memorial  chapel  built  near  or  over  a 
tomb,  where  the  friends  of  the  deceased 
would  meet  together  and  partake  of  a  feast 
iu  his  honour.    (See  Did.  Christ.  Ant.  327.) 

CBLLITES.  A  certain  religious  order 
of  Popish  Christians,  vfhich  has  houses  in 
Antwerp,  Louvain,  Mechlin,  Cologne,  and 
in  other  towns  in  Germany  and  the  Ne- 
therlands, whose  founder  was  one  Mexius, 
a  Roman,  mentioned  in  the  history  of 
Italy,  where  they  are  also  called  Mexians. — 
Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  ii.  285. 

CEMETERY.  KoiiMr^rfjpiov,  from  Kot/ida,  to 
sleep,  means  originally  a  place  to  sleep  in,  and 
hence  by  Christians,  who  regard  death  only  as 
a  kind  of  sleep,  from  which  men  are  to  awake 
at  the  general  resurrection ;  it  is  used  to 
designate  a  place  of  burial.  The  first  Chris- 
tian sepulchres  were  crypts  or  catacombs 
Area:  SepuUurarum  (see   Catacombs').    Ter- 


CENSURES 

tul.  ad  Scapul.  c.  3) ;  but  there  is  abundant 
evidence  that  there  were  open-air  cemeteries 
before  the  end  of  the  third  century.  The- 
custom  of  burying  in  churches  was  not 
practised  for  the  first  300  years  of  the 
Christian  era ;  and  severe  laws  were  passed 
against  burying  even  in  cities.  AH  corpses 
had  to  be  interred  without  the  walls. 
(Chrys.  Som.  67,  t.  v.  p.  989 ;  Chrys.  de 
Martyr,  t.  v.  p.  972.)  TTie  first  step  to- 
wards the  practice  of  burying  in  churches, 
was  the  transferring  of  the  relics  of  mar- 
tyrs thither:  next,  sovereigns  and  princes 
were  allowed  burial  in  the  porch :  in  the 
sixth  century  churchyards  came  into  use. 
By  degrees  the  practice  prevailed  from  the 
ninth  to  the  thirteenth  century,  encouraged 
first  by  special  grants  from  popes,  and  by 
connivance,  though  contrary  to  the  express 
laws  of  the  Church.  (See  Bingham,  bk. 
xxiii.  c.  1.)  The  word  cemetery  in  early 
Christian  documents  appears  frequently  to 
include  the  buildings,  memorial  chapels, 
oratories,  &c.,  which  were  erected  in  a 
graveyard.  Sometimes,  but  more  rarely,  it 
denotes  the  grave  itself.  (See  article  on 
"Cemetery"  in  Bictionary  of  Christian, 
Antiquities,  by  Canon  Venables,  and  the 
references  there  given.     See  Burial;  Con- 

CENOBITES.     (See  GoenoUtes.) 

CENOTAPH.  {KevoToxpiov,  from  Kfv'os 
and  rdtpos,  an  empty  tomb.)  A  memorial  of 
a  deceased  person,  not  erected  over  his 
body.  So  far  as  churches  may  be  con- 
sidered memorials  of  the  saints  whose 
name  they  bear,  they  are  analogous  either 
to  monuments,  when  the  bodies  of  the 
saints  there  repose  (as,  ,for  instance,  St. 
Alban's,  and  the  ancient  church  at  Peran- 
sabulo),  or  to  cenotaphs,  when,  as  is  far 
more  generally  the  case,  the  saint  is  buried 
far  off.  A  great  part  of  the  monuments 
which  disfigure  Westminster  Abbey  and 
St.  Paul's  are  cenotaphs. 

CENSER.     (See  Thurible.) 

CENSURES  ECCLESIASTICAL.  Th& 
penalties  by  which,  for  some  remarkable 
misbehaviour.  Christians  are  deprived  of 
the  communion  of  the  Church,  or  clergy- 
men are  prohibited  from  executing  the  sacer- 
dotal office.  These  censures  are,  excom- 
munication, suspension,  and  formerly  inter- 
dict. The  censures  on  clergymen  were  the 
more  severe,  for  laymen  could  not  of  course 
be  affected  by  suspension,  degradation,  or  re- 
duction to  lay  communion. — Bingham,  bk. 
xvii.  c.  1,  &c. 

The  canonists  define  an  ecclesiastical 
censure  to  be  a  spiritual  punishment,  in- 
flicted by  some  ecclesiastical  judge,  where- 
by he  deprives  a  person  baptized  of  the  use 
of  some  spiritual  things,  which  conduce, 
not   only   to    his    present  welfare  in  the 


CENTENARIUS 

Churcli,   but    likewise  to  his   future   and 
eternal  salvation. 

Whatever  may  have  beeu  the  case  in  for- 
mer times,  ecclesiastical  censures  of  laymen 
j>ro  salute  animx  can  hardly  be  said  legally 
to  exist  now  in  consequence  of  sundry  acts 
of  parliament,  except  that  they  may  still  bo 
monished  by  the  ecclesiastical  courts  against 
interfering  in  any  unlawful  way  in  ecclesiasti- 
cal matters,  as,  for  instance,  performing  divine 
service  and  preaching  in  a  church,  except 
reading  the  lessons  and  saying  or  singing 
the  psalms,  as  a  lay  defendant  was  by  the 
Court  of  Arches  in  Johnson  v.  Freind, 
6  Jur.,  N.S.,  280,  for  reading  the  burial  ser- 
vice in  a  churchyard — of  course  before  the 
Burials  Act  of  1880.  (See  Burial.)  And 
disobedience  may  still  be  "  signified  "  as  con- 
tempt, which  means  imprisonment.  Any 
one  making  alterations  in  a  church  without 
a  faculty  may  be  monished  to  restore  it  to  its 
former  condition.  That  was  pronounced  a 
serious  ecclesiastical  offence  in  Sieveking  v. 
Kingsford,  36  L.  J.,  N.S.  And  some  church- 
wardens were  signified  and  imprisoned  for 
contempt,  even  by  an  archdeacon's  court  a 
few  years  ago.  The  ecclesiastical  censures 
on  clergymen  are  suspension,  deprivation, 
and  degradation,  or  deposition  from  orders, 
excommunication  being  extinct.  Nor  has 
degradation  been  inflicted  foralong  time.  [G.] 

CENTENAEI  US.  An  officer  in  a  mona- 
stery who  presided  over  100  monks,  as  the 
decasius  presidedover  10. — Bingham,  bk.  vii. 
C.3. 

CENTUEIES,  MAGDEBUEG.  A  cele- 
brated and  extraordinary  ecclesiastical  his- 
tory, projected  by  Matthias  Flacius,  and 
prosecuted  by  him,  in  conjunction  with 
several  others,  many  of  them  divines  of 
Magdeburg.  Their  names  were  Nicolaus 
Gallus,  Johannes  Wigandus,  and  Matthias 
Judex,  all  ministers  of  Madgeburg,  as- 
sisted by  Caspar  Nidpruckius,  an  Imperial 
Counsellor,  Johannes  Baptista  Heincelius, 
an  Augustinian,  Basil  Faber,  and  others. 
The  centuriators  thus  describe  the  process 
€mployed  in  the  composition  of  their  work. 
Five  directors  were  appointed  to  manage 
the  whole  design;  and  ten  paid  agents 
supplied  the  necessary  labour.  Seven  of 
these  were  well-informed  students,  who 
were  employed  in  making  collections  from 
the  various  pieces  set  before  them.  Two 
others,  more  advanced  in  years,  and  of 
greater  learning  and  judgment,  arranged 
the  matter  thus  collected,  submitted  it  to 
the  directors,  and,  if  it  were  approved,  em- 
ployed it  in  the  composition  of  the  work. 
As  fast  as  the  various  chapters  were  com- 
posed, they  were  laid  before  certain  in- 
spectors, selected  from  the  directors,  who 
carefuUy  examined  what  had  been  done, 
and  made  the  necessary  alterations ;   and. 


CEREMONY 


149 


finally,  a  regular  amanuensis  made  a  fair 
copy  of  the  whole. 

At  length,  in  the  year  1560  (though 
probably  printed  in  1559),  appeared^  the 
first  volume  of  their  laborious  undertaking. 
It  was  printed,  at  Basle.  But  the  city  in 
which  the  first  part  of  it  was  composed  has 
given  it  a  distinctive  title;  and  the  first 
great  Protestant  work  on  Church  history 
has  been  always  commonly  'kno^vn  as  the 
Magdeburg  Centuries.  Thirteen  volumes 
folio  were  produced  between  1560  and  1574, 
each  containing  the  history  of  a  century. 
The  exact  title  of  the  work  is  Historic 
Ecclesiasticse  per  aliquot  studiosos  et  pios 
viros  in  Urhe  Magdeburgicd  Centurix  xiii. 

It  was,  in  every  point  of  view,  an  extra- 
ordinary production.  Though  the  first 
modem  attempt  to  illustrate  the  history  of 
the  Church,  it  was  written  upon  a  scale 
which  has  scarcely  been  exceeded.  It 
brought  to  light  a  large  quantity  of  un- 
published materials;  and  cast  the  whole 
subject  into  a  fixed  and  regular  form. 
One  of  its  most  remarkable  features  is  the 
elaborate  classification.  This  was  strictly 
original,  and,  with  all  its  inconveniences, 
undoubtedly  tended  to  introduce  scientific 
arrangement  and  minute  accuracy  into 
the  study  of  Church  history.  Each  cen- 
tury is  treated  separately,  in  sixteen  head? 
or  chapters.  The  first  of  these  gives  o 
general  view  of  the  history  of  the  century  ; 
then  follow,  2.  The  extent  and  propaga- 
tion of  the  Church.  3.  Persecution  and 
tranquillity  of  the  Church.  4.  Doctrine. 
5.  Heresies.  6.  Eites  and  Ceremonies. 
7.  Government.  8.  Schisms.  9.  Coun- 
cils. 10.  Lives  of  Bishops  and  Doctors. 
11.  Heretics.  12.  Martyrs.  13.  Miracles. 
14.  Condition  of  the  Jews.  15.  Other  re- 
ligions not  Christian.  16.  Political  con- 
dition of  the  world. — Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  ii.  521,  and  note. 

Mr.  Dowling  {Introduction  to  tJie  Critical 
Study  of  Ecclesiastical  History)  observ'es, 
that  this  peculiarity  of  form  rendered  the 
work  of  the  centuriators  rather  a  collection 
of  separate  treatises,  than  a  compact  and 
connected  history ;  while,  their  object  being 
to  support  a  certain  form  of  polemical 
theology,  their  relations  are  often  twisted 
to  suit  their  particular  views. 

CEEDONIANS.  Heretics  of  the  se- 
cond century,  followers  of  Cerdo.  The 
heresy  consisted  chiefly  in  laying  down  the 
existence  of  two  contrary  principles ;  in 
rejecting  the  law,  and  the  prophets  as 
ministers  of  a  bad  God ;  in  ascribing,  not 
a  true  body,  but  only  the  phantasm  of  a 
body,  to  our  blessed  Lord,  and  in  denying 
the  resurrection. — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim, 
i.  143. 
CEBEMONY.     This  word  Is  of  Latin 


150 


CEKEMONY 


origin,  though  some  of  the  best  critics  ia 
antiquity  are  divided  in  their  opinions,  in 
determining  ■  the  original  from  which  it  is 
derived.  Joseph  Scaliger  proves  by  ana- 
logy, that  as  sandimonia  comes  from 
sanctus,  so  does  ceremonia  from  the  old 
Latin  word  cerus,  which  .signifies  sacred  or 
holy.  The  Christian  writers  have  adopted 
the  word  to  signify  external  rites  and  customs 
in  the  worship  of  God ;  which,  though  they 
are  not  of  the  essence  of  religion,  yet  contri- 
bute much  to  good  order  and  uniformity  in 
the  Church. 

I.  From  the  very  earliest  ages  .of  the 
Church  certain  ceremonies  were  observed  in 
divine  worship.  Indeed,  as  St.  Augustine 
said,  "No  religion  can  exist  without  some 
ceremonies."  But  these  were  kept  within 
proper  and  reverent  limits;  and  when  cer- 
tain persons  wanted  to  introduce  some  ex- 
travagances into  tlie  service,  St.  Chrysostom 
spoke  strongly  against  them.  (Horn,  i.,  de 
verb.  Esai,  t.  iii.  p.  836  ;  also  Horn.  xix.  p. 
195.)  St.  Augustine,  also,  complained  of 
the  number  of  ceremonies  that  were  creeping 
in  {E;p.  Iv.  ad  Jan.  c.  xix.  35);  but  he 
urged  tolerance  with  regard  to  different 
customs  held  in  different  places  (Ep. 
Ixxxvi.).  Gregory  the  Great  urged  Augustine 
of  Canterbury  not  to  be  troubled  about  the 
difference  between  the  Roman  and  Gallican 
customs,  but  "  select  what  things  are  pious, 
reUgious  and  right."  {Bespons.  ad  qusesf. ; 
Bede,  lib.  i.  c.  27.).  In  the  middle  ages 
ceremonial  and  superstitious  observances 
increased  to  such  an  extent  that  "the 
burden  of  them  was  intolerable." — P.  B. 
Introd.,  and  "  Of  Ceremonies." 

II.  At  the  Eeformation  the  tendency  of 
the  extreme  Eeformers,  and  afterwards  of 
the  Puritan,  was  to  do  away  with  forms  and 
ceremonies  altogether.  The  Reformation, 
says  Sherlock,  gave  such  a  turn  to  weak 
heads,  that  had  not  weight  enough  to  poise 
themselves  between  the  extremes  of  Popery 
and  fanaticism,  that  everything  older  than 
yesterday  was  looked  upon  to  be  Popish  and 
anti-Christian.  At  the  same  time,  Calvin,  in 
his  book  of  the  True  Way  of  Eeformation, 
said  he  would  not  contend  about  ceremonies, 
not  only  those  which  are  for  decency,  but 
those  that  are  symbolical.  Bucer  thought 
the  use  of  the  sign  of  the  cross  after  baptism 
neither  indecent  nor  unprofitable.  Grotius 
says,  that  the  "  nature  of  ceremonies  is  to  be 
taken  from  the  doctrine  which  goes  along 
with  them;  if  the  doctrine  be  good,  the 
rites  are  ,w,  or  at  least  are  tolerable ;  if  it 
be  false,  then  they  are  troublesome  and  not 
to  be  borne."  Moreover,  Bucer,  in  a  letter 
to  Johannes  a  Lasco,  says,  "  If  you  will  not 
admit  such  liberty  and  use  of  vesture  to 
this  pure  and  holy  Church,  because  they 
have  no  commandment  of  the  Lord,  nor  no 


CEREMONY 

example  for  it,  I  do  not  see  how  you  can 
grant  to  any  Church,  that  it  may  celebrate 
the  Lord's  Supper  in  the  morning,  &c. ;  lor 
we  have  received  for  these  things  no  com- 
mandment of  1he  Lord,  nor  any  example;, 
yea,  rather,  the  Lord  gave  a  contraiy 
example." 

The  rule  of  the  English  Eefoi-mers  is  thus 
given  by  Bishop  Jewel : — We  still  keep  and 
esteem,  not  only  those  ceremonies  which  we 
are  sure  were  delivered  us  from  the  Apostles, 
but  some  others  too  besides,  which  we 
thought  might  be  suffered  without  hurt  to 
the  Church  of  God ;  for  that  we  had  a  desire- 
that  all  things  in  the  holy  congregation 
might,  as  St.  Paul  commandeth,  be  done- 
with  comeliness  and  in  good  order.  But  as 
for  all  those  things  which  we  saw  were 
either  very  superstitious,  or  utterly  un- 
profitable, or  noisome,  or  mockeries,  or 
contrary  to  the  Holy  Scriptures,  or  else 
unseemly  for  sober  and  discreet  people, 
whereof  there  be  infinite  numbers  uow-a- 
days,  ivhere  the  Roman  religion  is  used; 
these,  I  say,  we  have  utterly  refused  with- 
out all  manner  of  exception,  because  we 
would  not  have  the  right  worshipping  of 
God  to  be  defiled  any  longer  with  such 
follies. 

III.  The  portion  of  the  Introduction  to 
the  P.  B.  entitled  "Of  Ceremonies,  why 
some  be  abolished  and  some  retained,"  was 
written  by  Archbishop  Cranmer — at  least  it 
is  included  in  some  early  lists  of  his  works. 
It  was  placed,  first,  at  the  end  of  the  P.  B  , 
and  was  followed  by  certain  directions  with 
regard  to  vestures,  kneeling,  crossing,  holding 
up  of  hands,  &c.,  which  last  "may  be  used 
or  left  as  every  man's  devotion  serveth." 
These  were  omitted  in  1552,  and  the  part 
"  Of  Ceremonies  "  was  placed  as  at  present. 
It  has  been  said  that  the  only  ceremonies 
enjoined  there,  and  in  the  book  of  1662, 
properly  speaking;  are  the  cross  in  baptism, 
and  the  wedding-ring.  But  it  must  be 
remembered  that  Ceremonia  in  its  classical 
sense  was  a  general  term  for  worship. 
Johnson's  definition,  outward  rite,  external 
form  in  religion,  is  fully  supported  by  his 
references,  and  especially  Hooker,  who, 
throughout  his  book,  appUes  it  to  all  that  is 
external  in  worship.  It  seems  that  rite  and 
ceremony  are  thus  to  be  distinguished.  A 
rite  is  an  act  of  religious  worship,  whether 
including  ceremonies  or  not.  A  ceremony 
is  any  particular  of  religious  worship  (in- 
cluded in  a  rite),  which  prescribes  action, 
position,  or  even  the  assumption  of  any 
particular  vesture.  The  latter  sense  is 
plainly  recognised  by  Hooker.  {Ecd.  Pol. 
bk.  iv.  sect.  1;  bk.  v.  sect.  29.)  The 
Preface  to  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer 
speaks  first  of  common  prayer,  viz.  the 
offices     intended    for    the    common    and 


CERINTHIANS 

periodical  use  of  all  at  stated  times;  next, 
the  admiuistration  of  tlie  sacraments ;  next, 
of  other  rites  and  ceremonies ;  i.e.  the  occa- 
sional services,  whether  public  or  private, 
and  all  the  methods  of  administration 
■which  these  involve.  Now  among  cere- 
monies, the  prescribed  procession  in  the 
Marriage  and  Burial  Services,  the  standing 
at  certain  parts  of  the  service,  the  bowing 
at  the  name  of  Jesus,  as  prescribed  by  the 
18th  canon,  ought  to  be  included.  It  may 
be  obseiTed,  that  the  18th  canon  expressly 
calls  the  bowing  just  mentioned,  a  ceremony, 
as  also  in  the  30th  canon,  the  sign  of  the 
cross. — See  Hooker,  bk.  iii.  sect.  11,  and  bk. 
V.  sect.  6 ;  Stephens's  Com.  P.  B.,  vol.  i.  p. 
139.  But  there  is  a  legal  distinction 
between  ceremonies  prescribed  as  parts  of 
the  service,  such  as  the  use  of  the  cross  in 
baptism,  the  ring  in  marriage,  the  lay- 
ing on  of  hands  in  ordiuation,  and  so 
forth,  and  mere  extraneous  ceremonies, 
which  may  be  called  authorised  but  not 
enforceable.     [H.] 

CEBINTHIANS.  Ancient  heretics,  the 
followers  of  Cerinthus.  This  man,  who 
was  a  Jew  by  birth,  and  lived  probably 
near  the  end  of  the  first  century  at  Ephesus, 
having  been  educated  at  Alexandria,  at- 
tempted to  form  a  new  and  singular  system 
of  doctrine  and  discipline,  by  combining  the 
doctrines  of  Christ  with  the  opinions  and 
errors  of  the  Jews  and  Gnostics.  He 
taught  that  the  Creator  of  the  world,  whom 
he  considered  also  as  the  Sovereign  and 
Lawgiver  of  the  Jews,  was  a  Being  endued 
with  the  greatest  virtues,  and  derived  his 
birth  from  the  Supreme  God;  that  this 
Being  gradually  degenerated  from  his  for- 
mer virtue ;  that,  in  consequence  of  this,  the 
Supreme  Being  determined  to  destroy  his 
empire,  and,  for  that  purpose,  sent  upon 
earth  one  of  the  ever  happy  and  glorious 
aeons  whose  name  was  Christ;  that  this 
Christ  chose  for  his  habitation  the  person 
of  Jesu!--,  into  whom  he  entered  in  the  form 
of  a  dove,  whilst  Jesus  was  receiving  bap- 
tism of  John  in  the  waters  of  Jordan  ;  that 
Jesus,  after  this  union  with  Christ,  opposed 
the  God  of  the  Jews,  at  whose  instigation 
he  was  seized  and  crucified  by  the  Hebrew 
chiefs ;  that  when  Jesus  was  taken  captive, 
Christ  ascended  on  high,  and  the  man  Jesus 
alone  was  subjected  to  the  pain  of  an 
ignominious  death. — Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i. 
90 ;  Irenaeus,  adv.  Hmr.  iii.  3. 

CESSION.  This  is  where  the  incum- 
bent of  any  living  is  promoted  to  some 
other  benefice  incompatible  with  his  tenure 
of  the  former ;  the  church  in  that  case  is 
void  by  cession.  When  a  parson  possessed 
of  ecclesiastical  benefices  of  any  kind,  except 
unendowed  canonries,  is  promoted  to  a 
bishopric  in  England,  they  become  void  by 


CHALCEDON 


151 


cession,  and  the  right  of  presentation  be- 
longs to  the  Crown. 

CHAD,  or  CEADDA.  Saint  and 
Bishop;  a  man  of  singular  piety  and  holi- 
ness of  life,  commemorated  in  the  English 
Calendar  on  March  2nd.  Educated  partly 
at  Lindisfarne  under  St.  Aidan,  partly  in  au 
Irish  Monastery,  he  was  afterwards  conse- 
crated Bishop  of  York  (a.d.  664),  but 
resigned  that  see  in  favour  of  Wilfred 
(a.d.  669).  He  was  made  bishop  of  the 
Mercians  in  670,  and  fixed  his  see  at  Lich- 
field and  lived  at  Eccleshall,  which  re- 
mained the  bishop's  seat  till  1868.  He  died 
in  672. 

CHALCEDON,  COUNCILS  OF.  It  would 
not  be  necessary  to  refer  to  that  council, 
which  was  called  the  "  Synod  of  the  Oak," 
from  the  name  of  a 'suburb  of  the  city,  were 
it  not  that  by  it  St.  John  Chrysostom  was 
deposed  403  a.d.  Through  the  machinations 
of  Theophilus,  who  assumed,  as  patriarch 
of  Alexandria,  supremacy  over  all  Eastern 
bishops,  a  council  of  thirty-six  bishops,  of 
whom  all  but  seven  were  Egyptian,  was 
assembled  with  the  intention  of  getting  rid 
of  St.  Chrysostom,  who  had  offended  them 
by  his  strictness  of  life,  and  denunciation 
of  prevalent  vices.  The  charges  brought 
against  St.  Chrysostom  were  frivolous ;  but 
still  the  council  pronounced  against  him, 
and  the  weak  emperor  Arcadius  confirmed 
this  sentence.  With  the  people  Chryso- 
stom was  most  popular,  and  riots  ensued  in 
consequence  of  the  attitude  of  the  emperor 
and  bishops  towards  him  ;  nevertheless  he 
was  condemned  to  exile,  which  sentence  was 
afterwards  ratified  by  another  "  packed " 
council  at  Constantinople.  (See  Constanti- 
nople, Councils  of.  For  a  full  account  see 
Stephens's  Life  of  St.  John  Chrysostom, 
second  edition,  pp.  309-339.) 

The  fourth  General  ComkcjZ,  was  convened 
by  the  emperor  Marcian  in  451,  shortly 
after  his  elevation  to  the  throne.  It  was 
very  fully  attended,  and  according  to  some 
accounts  630  bishops  were  present  (Beve- 
rirtge,  ii.  107).  But  perhaps  the  6  and  3 
were  misplaced  in  the  record,  and  360 
would  represent  the  number  of  bishops  at 
the  (<pening  of  the  council.  There  were 
more,  however,  afterwards,  for  470  sub- 
scribed to  the  fifth  action,  and  indeed  the 
council  is  spoken  of  as  one  of  600  bishops. 
(Mansi,  vii.  57,  .note.) 

The  chief  object  was  to  settle  the  matter 
of  the  heresy  of  Eutyches,  who  maintained 
that  there  was  only  one  nature  in  Christ, 
namely,  the  Woi-cCs,  hut  that  an  incarnate 
nature.  (See  JEuiychians.)  At  a  previous 
council,  managed  by  the  Eutyohians,  in 
Theodosius  ll.'s  reign,  the  doctrine  of  tuo 
natures  in  the  Incarnate  Word  had  been 
condemned,     and     Dioscorus,     bishop     of 


152 


CHALD^I 


Alexandria,  had  compelled  by  violence,  with 
the  aid  of  a  band  of  soldiers,  149  bishops 
to  sign  in  favour  of  the  ideas  of  Eutyches. 
This  is  kno\vn  as  the  "  Jobbers'  Assembly," 
as  everything  was  cavried  by  fraud  and 
violence.  But  in  the  Council  of  Chalcedon 
the  acts  of  the  Ephesine,  or  "Kobbers"' 
council,  were  rescinded,  and  Dioscorus  was 
deposed,  and  banished.  The  exposition  of 
faith  in  the  fifth  action  of  this  council  was 
designed  to  guard  against  both  Eutyohian 
and  Nestorian  errors.  (See  Neslorians.) 
After  recognising  the  Nicene  Creed,  they 
proceed  to  say:  "Following,  therefore, 
these  holy  fathers,  we  unitedly  declare, 
that  one  and  the  same  Son,  our  Lord 
Jesus  Christ,  is  to  be  acknowledged,  as 
being  perfect  in  Uis  Godhead,  and  per- 
fect in  His  humanity ;  truly  God,  and  truly 
Man,  with  a  rational  soul  and  body;  of 
like  essence  (o/ioouo-ior)  ■with  the  Father,  as 
to  His  Godhead ;  and  of  like  essence  with 
us,  as  to  His  manhood;  in  all  things  like 
unto  us,  sin  excepted;  begotten  of  the 
Father,  from  all  eternity,  as  to  His  Godhead ; 
and  of  Mary  the  mother  of  God  (Bcotokov) 
in  these  last  days  for  us  and  for  our  salva- 
tion, as  to  His  manhood,  recognised  as  one 
Christ,  Son,  Lord,  only  begotten;  of  two 
natures,  unconfounded,  inseparable;  the 
distinction  of  natures  not  at  all  done  away 
by  the  imion  ;  but  rather  the  peculiarity  of 
each  nature  preserved,  and  combining  into 
one  substance ;  not  separated  or  divided 
into  two  persons  :  but  one  Son,  only-begotten, 
God  the  Word,  the  Lord  Jesus  Christ,  as 
the  prophets  before  [taughtj  concerning 
Him :  so  He,  the  Lord  Jesus,  hath  taught 
us,  and  the  creed  of  the  Fathers  hath 
transmitted  to  us." — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mo- 
slieim,  i.  374 ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.     [H.] 

CHALD^I,  or  CHALDEANS.  Astro- 
logers or  Masicians,  deriving  their  name 
from  the  prophets  of  the  East,  celebrated 
for  their  magical  arts.  They  professed  to 
foretell  future  events,  and  to  discover 
secrets  by  the  position  and  motion  of  the 
stars,  and  by  enchantments.  Under  the 
Koman  emperors  many  edicts  were  pub- 
lished against  them  as  impostors  aad 
introducers  of  dangerous  superstitions,  and 
they  were  styled  in  the  Codes,  "  Malefici  et 
Mathematici."  {Cod.  Tlieod.  9,  lib.  16;  Cod. 
Just.  9,  38;  see  also  Sac.  Annal.  ii.  32; 
Sueton.  Tiber.  36 ;  Vitell.  14,  &c.)  Amongst 
Christians  the  practice  of  these  arts  was 
absolutely  forbidden  by  councils  (Cone. 
Tolet.  1;  Cone.  Laod.  c.  36),  and  by 
those  in  authority  {Constit.  Apost.  i.  4 ; 
viii.  32).  Many  of  the  fathers  also  wrote 
against  all  kinds  of  divination  as  owing 
its  origin  to  the  evil  one,  and  as  the  parent 
of  all  sorts  of  blasphemy  and  deceit. — 
Aug.  de  Boet.  Christ,  ii.  21,  de  Civ.  Dei,  v. 


CHALICE 

1,  &c.;  TertuU.  de  Idol.  9;  Origen,  Euse- 
bius,  &c.     [H.l 

CHALDEANS.  A  modem  sect  of  Chris- 
tians in  the  East,  in  obedience  to  the  see  of 
Eome.  In  1681,  the  Nestorian  metroiwlitan 
of  Diarbekir,  haviog  quarrelled  with  his 
patriarch,  was  first  consecrated  by  the  pope 
patriarch  of  the  Chaldeans.  The  sect  was 
as  new  as  the  ofiice,  and  created  for  it. 
Converts  to  Papacy  from  the  Nestorians 
"  were  dignified  with  the  name  of  the 
Chaldean  Church.  It  means  no  more  than 
Papal  Syrians,  as  we  have  in  other  parts 
Papal  Armenians  and  Papal  Greeks."  (See 
Neslorians ;  Badger's  Nestorians  and  tkeir 
Rituals,  vol.  i.  pp.  177,  181;  Stubbs' 
Mosheim,  i.  372. 

CHALDEE  LANGUAGE.  This  was  a 
dialect  of  the  Hebrew,  almost  identical  with 
the  old  Syriac,  spoken  formerly  in  Assyria, 
and  the  vernacular  language  of  the  Jews 
after  the  Babylonish  captivity.  The  follow- 
ing parts  of  the  Old  Testament  are  written 
in  Chaldee :  Jer.  x.,  xi. ;  Dan.  ii.  4  to  the 
end  of  chap.  vii. ;  Ezra  iv.  8  to  vi.  19,  and 
vii  12-17. 

CHALDEE  PABAPHEASE.  (See  Tar- 
gum.) 

CHALICE.  (Lat.  calix.)  This  word 
was  formerly  (as  by  Shakspeare)  used  to 
denote  any  sort  of  cup,  but  is  now  usually 
restricted  to  the  cup  in  which  the  con- 
secrated wine  for  the  Eucharist  is  adminis- 
tered. The  primitive  Christians,  desirous 
of  honouring  the  holy  purpose  for  which  it 
was  used,  had  it  made  of  the  most  costly 
substances  their  circumstances  would  allow 
— of  glass,  crystal,  onyx,  sardonyx,  and  gold. 
(See  on 'this  point  Bingham,  bk.  viii.  c.  vi. 
§  21.)  Afterwards  inferior  material  seems  in 
certain  places  to  have  been  used,  for  in  some 
provincial  councils  the  use  of  wood  or  horn 
was  prohibited  (Cone.  Tribur.  c.  18  ;  Cone. 
Caleut.  c.  10),  and  by  a  canon  of  the  Coimoil 
of  Eheims,  in  Charles  the  Great's  time,  all 
churches  were  obhged  to  have  chalices  of 
some  pure  metal.  The  ancient  chalices 
were  of  two  kinds:  the  greater,  in  which 
the  wine  mingled  with  water  (as  was 
always  the  custom  in  those  days)  was  con- 
secrated; and  the  lesser,  called  ministeriales, 
into  which  the  priest  poured  a  smaU 
quantity,  that  it  might  be  administered  to 
the  people ;  for  communion  in  one  kind  was 
not  then  invented  by  the  Eomish  Church. 
It  was  an  ancient  rule  that  there  should 
not  be  more  than  one  chalice  on  the  altar,  to 
which  Gregory  II.  alludes  in  his  epistle  to 
Boniface,  a.d.  731.  (Ducange.)  See  Cup ; 
Communion  in  one  kind  ;  Mixed  Chalice. 

The  earliest  chalice  known  to  be  existing 
is  one  found  at  Gourdon  in  France,  and  now 
preserved  in  the  Biblioth&quo  Imp^riale  in 
Paris.     It  is  made  of  gold  ornamented  with 


CHALONS-SUR-SAONE 

tliia  slices  of  garnets,  and  from  the  date 
and  condition  of  some  gold  coins  fomid  with 
it,  it  is  believed  to  belong  to  the  first  quarter 
of  the  sixth  century.     [H  ] 

CHAI.ONS-SUK-SAONB,  Councils  of 
•(^CabiUonensia  Concilia),  five  in  number — 
the  first  held  in  470,  tlie  fifth  in  650.  The 
appointment  or  deposition  of  certain  bishops, 
and  the  regulation  of  discipline,  were  the 
objects  of  these  councils. 

CHAMFER.  The  flat  slope  formed  by 
•cutting  away  an  angle  in  timber,  or  ma- 
sonry. It  resembles  a  splay,  but  is  much 
smaller.  The  chamfer  is  ihe  first  approach 
to  a  moulding,  though  it  can  hardly  itself 
be  called  one.  The  chamfer  plane,  in 
speaking  of  mouldings,  is  used  for  the 
plane  at  an  angle  of  45°,  or  thereabouts, 
with  the  face  of  the  wall,  in  which  some  of 
the  mouldings  often,  and  sometimes  all  of 
them,  lie.  The  resolution  of  the  chamfer  into 
the  square  is  called  a  stop-chamfer ;  which 
frequently  have  ornamental  terminations, 
indicative  of  the  style  to  which  they  belong. 

CHANCEL.  The  upper  part  of  the 
church,  containing  the  Holy  Table,  and 
the  stalls  for  the  clergy.  It  is  so  called  a 
Cancellis,  from  the  lattice-work  partition 
betwixt  the  choir  and  the  body  of  the 
•church,  so  framed  as  to  separate  the  one 
from  the  other,  but  not  to  intercept  the 
sight.  By  the  rubric  before  the  Common 
Prayer,  it  is  ordained  that  "the  chancels 
•shall  remain  as  they  have  done  in  times 
past,"  that  is  to  say,  distinguished  from  the 
body  of  the  church  as  they  then  were, 
against  which  distinction  Bucer  (at  the 
time  of  the  Reformation)  inveighed  vehe- 
mently, as  tending  only  to  magnify  the 
priesthood;  but  though  the  king  and  the 
parliament  yielded  so  far  as  to  allow  the 
•daily  service  to  be  read  in  the  body  of  the 
church,  if  the  ordinary  thought  fit,  yet 
they  woTild  not  suifer  the  chancel  to  be 
taken  away  or  altered.  In  cathedrals, 
college  chapels,  and  some  large  churches  it 
is  called  the  [chorit  or]  choir ;  and  in  many 
of  the  ancient  English  parish  churches  it  is 
inferior'  in  height  and  width  to  the  nave, 
but  never  was  in  old  times  with  a  central 
tower,  unless  the  nave  and  choir  were  of 
different  ages;  or  even  with  a  bell-gable 
between  them :  a  distinction  now  usually 
overlooked.     (See  Choir.) 

The  chancel  is  the  freehold  of  the  rector, 
even  when  he  is  not  the  incumbent ;  and  he 
is  bound  to  repair  it ;  but  an  incumbent  is 
not  bound  to  repair  the  rest  of  the  church, 
though  it  is  also  his  freehold.  With  regard 
to  seats  in  the  church,  the  rector  impropri- 
ate is  entitled  to  the  chief  seat.  But  fre- 
quently the  old  custom  of  the  clergy  and 
choir  only  having  seats  in  the  chancel  is 
followed.     This  however  is  under  the  dis- 


CHANCELLOR 


153 


position  of  the  ordinary.  "With  regard  to 
the  situation  of  the  Lord's  Table  iu  the 
chancel,  see  Altar.     [H.] 

CHANCELLOR.  I.  In  ancient  times, 
emperors  and  kings  esteemed  so  highly  the 
piety  of  bishops,  that  they  gave  tliem  ju- 
risdiction in  particular  causes,  as  in  mar- 
riages, adultery,  last  wills,  &c.,  which  were 
determined  by  them  in  their  consistory 
courts.  But  when  many  controversies 
arose  in  these  and  other  causes,  it  was  not 
consistent  with  the  character  of  a  bishop 
to  interpose  in  every  litigious  matter,  nei- 
ther could  he  despatch  it  himself;  and 
therefore  it  was  necessary  for  the  bishop 
to  depute  some  surbordinate  officer,  expe- 
rienced both  in  the  civil  and  canon  law,  to 
determine  those  ecclesiastical  causes:  and 
this  was  the  original  of  diocesan  chan- 
cellors. For,  in  the  first  ages  of  the 
Church,  the  bishops  had  officers  who  were 
called  ecclesiecdici,  that  is,  church  lawyers, 
who  were  bred  up  in  the  knowledoe  of 
the  civil  and  canon  law,  and  their  business 
was  to  assist  the  bishop  in  his  jurisdiction 
throughout  the  whole  diocese.  But  pro- 
bably they  were  not^  judges  of  ecclesias- 
tical courts,  as  chancellors-  are  at  this  day, 
but  only  advised  and  assisted  the  bishops 
themselves  in  giving  judgment ;  for  we 
read  of  no  chancellors  here  in  all  the 
Saxon  reigus,  nor  after  the  Conquest,  be- 
fore the  time  of  Heniy  II.  That  king 
requiring  the  attendance  of  bishops  in  his 
state  councils,  and  other  public  affairs,  it 
was  thought  necessary  to  substitute  chancel- 
lors in  their  room,  to  despatch  those  causes 
vrhich  were  properfor  thebishop's  jurisdiction. 

In  a  few  years  a  chancellor  became 
such  a  necessary  officer  to  the  bishop, 
that  he  was  not  to  be  without  him ;  for  if 
he  would -have  none,  the  archbishop  of 
the  province  might  enjoin  him  to  depute 
one,  and  if  he  refused  the  archbishop 
might  appoint  one  himself;  because  it  is 
presumed  that  a  bishop  alone  cannot 
decide  so  many  spiritual  causes  as  arise 
within  his  diocese.  The  person  thus  ap- 
pointed by  the  bishop  has  his  authority 
fi:om  the  law ;  and  his  jurisdiction  is  not, 
like  that  of  a  commissary,  limited  to  a 
certain  place  and  certain-  causes,  but  ex- 
tends throughout  the  whole  diocese,  and 
the  appointment  is  for  life.  But  a  good 
deal  of  this  jurisdiction  has  been  taken  away 
by  the  Clergy  Discipline  Act  of  1840,  and 
transferred  to  the  Provincial  Courts,  and 
all  the  testamentary  business  to  the  Probate 
and  Divorce  Court  in  1857.  See  Philli- 
more's  Ecc.  Law. 

The  Act  of  37  Hen.  VIII.  c.  17,  recited 
that  the  restriction  of  the  judicial  officer  of 
ecclesiastical  courts  to  clerics  was  a  popish 
usurpation,  and  threw  them  open  to  laymen 


154 


CHAi^CELLOK 


by  enacting  that  married  men,  being  doctors 
of  law  or  incorporated  in  any  university, 
being  duly  appointed,  may  examine  all 
manner  of  ecclesiastical  jurisdiction.  And 
this  was  not  considered  to  limit  the  ofBces  to 
doctors  of  law,  being  only  declaratory  of  the 
old  law ;  many  have  been  only  M.  A's.  There 
are  a  few  clerical  chancellors,  but  they  are 
mostly  lawyers,  and  it  is  evidently  desirable 
that  they  should  be,  as  they  have  to  decide  on 
legal  principles,  and  they  are  sometimes  a 
sort  of  standing  counsel  in  legal  matters  to 
the  bishop.  The  question  whether  the 
bishop  himself  can  sit  in  his  court,  any 
more  than  the  Queen,  seems  to  depend  on 
the  terms  of  the  appointments,  which  in  a 
few  dioceses  nominally  reserve  that  power, 
but  generally  not ;  and  even  where  it  is 
reserved  it  is  hardly  ever  exercised.  A  new 
power  of  sitting  with  assessors  was  given  to 
the  bishop  by  the  Clergy  Discipline  Act  of 
1840,  but  that  has  been  very  seldom  used, 
and  he  can  decide  nothing  without  being 
subject  to  appeal  to  the  Provincial  Court. 
The  only  directly  penal  jurisdiction  which 
seems  to  remain  to  the  chancellors  is  that  of 
suspending,  and  even  depriving  for  a  third 
offence,  clergymen  for  trading,  under  1  &  2 
Vict.  c.  106,  s.  31 :  which  is  further  remark- 
able because  it  had  been  considered  or  as- 
srmied  that  no  diocesan  chancellor  had  power 
himself  to  deprive,  by  Canon  122,  though 
the  provincial  judge  has.  At  any  rate,  Lord 
Stowell  once  called  in  the  Bishop  of  London 
to  deprive  a  clergyman  whom  he  as  chan- 
cellor (not  as  Dean  of  Arches)  had  sentenced 
to  be  deprived.  The  question  is  now 
obsolete,  but  if  such  was  not  the  law  before 
1603,  the  convocations  then  had  no  power  to 
make  it  so.  It  has  been  decided  that  the 
Dean  of  Arches  can  deprive :  indeed  he  has 
often  done  so.  The  principal  remaining 
function  of  the  chancellors  is  that  of  deciding 
oa  faculties  for  altering  churches  (see 
Faculty)  and  on  disputes  about  pews  in 
certain  cases.  The  chancellor  is  also  the 
bishop's  vicar-general  and  official  principal. 
It  is  singular  that  the  chancery  court  of 
York  is  provincial ;  and,  since  the  Public 
Worship  Act,  the  Dean  of  Arches  is  the  official 
principal  thereof.  The  chancellor  of  York  is 
only  judge  of  the  consistory  court,  which  is 
diocesan.  As  a,  fact,  but  not  of  necessity, 
he  is  generally  or  always  vicar-general  for 
the  province  also,  but  has  no  judicial  func- 
tions as  such.  (See  Vicar-General.)  [G.] 
II.  The  chancellor  of  cathedral  churches, 
and  anciently  in  some  colleges,  was  a  canon, 
who  had  the  general  care  of  the  literature 
of  the  church ;  and  of  the  preaching.  He 
was  the  secretary  of  the  chapter,  the 
librarian,  the  superintendent  of  schools  con- 
nected with  the  church,  sometimes  of  the 
greater  schools  in  the  diocese;  sometimes, 


CHANT 

as  in  Paris,  had  an  academical -jurisdiction- 
in  the  university  of  the  place.  He  also  had 
the  supervision  of  readers  in  the  choirs,  the 
regulation  of  preachers  in  the  cathedral,  and 
in  many  places  the  more  frequent  delivery 
of  sermons  and  of  theological  lectures  thaa 
fell  to  the  turn  of  the  other  canons. 
All  these  offices  were  not  always  com- 
bined; but  one  or  more  of  them  always- 
belonged  to  the  chancellor.  Every  cathe- 
dral of  old  foundation  in  England  had 
originally  a  chancellor,  who  ranked  as  the 
third  of  those  four  dignitaries  who  took 
precedence  of  all  other  members  of  the 
chapter,  the  other  three  being  the  dean, 
the  precentor,  and  the  treasurer.  The  title- 
was  not  so  common  in  France  or  Italy 
where  the  above-named  offices  were  fre- 
quently divided  among  canons  with  other 
official  titles.  The  chancellor  of  the  church 
(the  above-named  officer)  is  not  to  be 
confounded  with  the  chancellor  of  the 
diocese. — Jebh. 

CHANT.  This  word,  derived  from  the 
Latin  cantus,  "a  song,"  applies,  in  its 
most  extended  sense,  to  the  musical  per- 
formance of  all  those  parts  of  the  liturgy 
which,  by  the  rubric,  are  permitted  to  bo 
sung.  I'he  chant  properly  signifies  that 
plain  tune  to  which  the  prayers,  the  htany, 
the  versicles,  and  responses,  and  the  psalms, 
and  (where  services  are  not  in  use)  the 
canticles,  are  set,  in  choirs  and  places  where 
they  sing. 

The  early  history  of  the  chant  is  involved 
in  great  obscurity.  While  we  know  that 
music  had  a  great  part  in  the  services  of  the 
Temple,  and  that  our  Lord  and  his  disciples 
sang  hymns — or  the  "  hallel " — and  that  St. 
Paul  urged  the  singing  of  "  psalms  and 
hymns  and  spiritual  songs  " — yet  there  are 
no  works  extant  to  tell  us  the  character  of 
the  music :  and  the  chant  does  not  seem 
to  have  been  derived  from  a  Hebrew  source. 
St.  Ambrose  was  the  first  who  founded  a 
musical  school,  and  he  certainly  used  not 
Hebrew  but  Greek  modes  (see  Anibrosian 
Bite),  while  St.  Gregory,  about  200  years 
afterwards,  merely  improved  upon  St. 
Ambrose's  system,  and  brought  music  to  a 
much  greater  perfection  in  the  Divine 
Services  on  the  same  method.  (See 
Gregorian  Tones.) 

To  this  were  added  in  the  Western 
Churches  of  the  early  and  middle  ages 
certain  details,  until  it  may  be  said  the 
"  Cantus "  was  thus  divided  :  (i.)  Cantus^ 
Collectarum — the  chant  for  the  prayers, 
St.  Athanasius  objected,  according  to  Si, 
Augustine,  to  much  inflexion  of  voice  in 
the  saying  the  Divine  Office,  but  in  later 
times  considerable  inflexion  was  used,  (ii.) 
Cantus  Prophetarum,  or  chant  for  the 
Scripture    lections,   which   was    also   used 


CHANT 

for  the  versicles  and  responses.  The  in- 
flexions were  (a)  the  "  accentus  medius  " — 
dropping  the  voice  a  minor  third  (as  from 
Gr  to  -K)  at  each  comma ;  (j3)  the  "  accen- 
tus gravis" — dropping  a  perfect  fifth  (as 
from  G  to  C)  at  each  full  stop.  There 
was  al.so  the  "  accentus  acutus  "  (G,  E,  G) 
and  the  "  accentus  moderatus  "  (G,  B,  P  #), 
which  last,  with  the  "medius,"  is  commonly 
used  in  the  versicles  at  the  present  time  in 
the  Church  of  England,  (iii.)  Chants  for 
Psalms.  There  were  three  ways  of  singing 
the  Psalms,  (a)  the  "  Cantus  directus,"  in 
which  the  Psalm  is  sung  through  by  the 
■whole  choir ;  O)  the"  Cantus  Antiphonalis," 
in  which  the  choir  is  divided  into  two 
sides  and  sing  alternately ;  (y)  the  Cantus 
Eesponsarius,  in  which  the  precentor  and 
choir  sing  alternate  verses,  (iv.)  Chants 
for  hymns,  prefaces,  and  antiphons.  In  the 
later  mediiEval  times,  when  the  people  were 
not  supposed  to  take  part,  the  chant 
became  very  ornate  and  debased — as  many 
as  twenty  notes  or  more  being  given  to  one 
syllable.  This  evil  was  felt  both  in  Eng- 
land and  abroad,  and  when  our  English 
services  were  made  congregational  again, 
and  the  Prayer  Book  established  in  the 
vernacular,  steps  were  taken  to  reform  also 
the  "  Cantus." 

II.  In  a  letter  to  Henry  VIII.  Archbishop 
Cranmer,  presenting  to  His  Majesty  the 
English  "  Processional,"  or  book  of  services 
translated,  says  "  the  song  that  shall  be 
made  thereto  should  not  be  full  of  notes, 
not  as  near  as  may  be  a  syllable  for  any  note, 
so  that  it  may  be  sung  distinctly  and 
devoutly,  as  to  the  Matins  and  Even- 
song, Venite,  Hymns,  Te  Deum,  &c.  .  .  . 
and  in  the  Mass,  Gloria  in  Excdsis,  Gloria 
Fatri,  &c."  Upon  this  principle  the  Litany 
was  published  in  1544,  simply  set  to  the 
old  chant — which  was  subsequently  rehar- 
monized  by  Tallis ;  and  is  in  use  at  the 
present  time.  But  the  most  important 
work  was  the  "Booke  of  Common  Praier 
noted,"  edited  by  John  Merbecke,  and 
published  in  1549 — the  same  year  with 
Edward  VI. 's  first  Prayer  Book.  In  this 
for  the  prayers  the  "  Cantus  CoUectarum," 
for  the  versicles  and  responses  the  "Cantus 
Prophetarum"  is  used  (see  above);  but 
the  Scripture  lections  are  to  be  "sung, 
after  the  manner  of  distinct  reading."  To 
the  Te  Deum,  the  Ambrosian  melody  is 
set;  for  the  other  canticles,  the  Nicene 
Creed,  Gloria,  &c.,  simplified  forms  of 
Gregorian  melodies  are  used,  and  after  the 
Venite  (set  to  the  8th  Gregorlm  tone  1st 
ending)  the  words  occur,  "  And  so  forth  with 
the  rest  of  the  Psalms  as  they  are  ap- 
pointed." By  this  authorized  publication 
two  points  were  established ;  first,  that  our 
■services    did     not    lose    their    old    choral 


CHANTRY 


155 


character ;  and  secondly,  that  they  were 
made  of  so  plain  and -simple  a  character 
that  the  people  generally  might  participate. 
Afterwards  a  number  of  different  forms 
were  published  by  eminent  musicians,  but 
the  wonl  "  Chant "  hardly  applies  to  those 
musical  arrangements  of  the]  canticles, 
hymns,  and  of  the  Nicene  Creed,  used  in 
collegiate  churches,  and  technically  called 
"services,"  which  though  originally  de- 
rived from  chants,  have  long  found  a 
distinct  feature  in  the  choral  service,  and 
have  now  been  brought  to  great  musical 
perfection. 

HI.  There  are  two  kinds  of  chant  used 
at  the  present  day  for  the  Psalms — the 
Gregorian,  founded  on  the  old  tones,  and 
the  Anglican.  This  latter  is  of  two  kinds, 
single  and  double.  The  single  chant,  which 
is  the  most  ancient  kind,  is  an  air  con- 
sisting of  two  parts ;  the  first  part  ter- 
minating with  the  point  or  colon  (:), 
which  uniformly  divides  each  verse  of  the 
psalms  or  canticles  in  the  Prayer  Book,  the 
second  part  terminating  with  the  vers& 
itself.  The  double  chant  is  an  air  con- 
sisting of  four  strains,  and  consequently 
extending  to  two  verses.  This  kind  of 
chant  does  not  appear  to  be  older  than  the 
time  of  Charles  II. ;  and  is  peculiar  to  the 
Church  of  England.     (See  Music.)    [H.] 

CHANTER  or  CANTOR.  (See  Pre- 
centor.) In  foreign  churches  it  is  syn- 
onymous with  our  lay  clerks.  The' 
chanters  in  Dublin  College  are  certain 
officers  selected  from  the  foundation 
students,  whose  duty  is  to  ofiiciate  as 
chapel  clerks.  They  are  so  called  from 
formerly  constituting  the  choir  of  the 
chapel. 

CHANTRY.  A  chapel,  or  other  sepa- 
rated place  in  a  church,  for  the  celebration 
of  masses  for  the  soul  of  some  person  de- 
parted this  life.  The  chantry  sometimes  in- 
cluded the  tomb  of  the  person  by  whom  it 
was  founded,  as  in  the  splendid  examples  in 
Winchester  cathedral.  It  was  sometimes- 
an  entire  aisle,  as  the  golden  choir  at  St. 
Mary's,  Stamford ;  and  sometimes  a  sepa- 
rate chapel,  as  the  Beaucharap  chapel,  St. 
Mary's,  Warwick,  and  Henry  VII.'s  chapel 
at  Westminster. 

In  the  reign  of  Henry  VIII.,  when  the 
belief  in  purgatory  began  to  decline,  it 
was  thought  an  unncessary  thing  to  con- 
tinue the  pensions  and  endowments  of 
chantry  priests;  therefore,  in  the  37  of 
Henry  VIII.  cap.  4,  those  chantries  were 
given  to  the  king,  who  had  power  at  any 
time  to  issue  commissions  to  seize  their 
endowments,  and  take  them  into  his  pos- 
session: but  this  being  in  the  last  year  of 
his  reign,  there  were  several  of  those  en- 
dowments which  were  not  seized  by  virtue 


156 


CHAPEL 


of  any  such  commissions;  therefore,  by  the 
Act  1  Edward  VI.  cap.  14,  those  chantries 
•which  were  in  being  five  years  before 
the  session  of  that  parHament,  and  not 
in  the  actual  possession  of  Henry  VHL, 
were  adjudged  to  be,  and  were,  vested  in 
that  king.  Cranmer  endeavoured  to  ob- 
tain that  the  disposal  of  the  chantries,  &c., 
should  he  deferred  until  the  king  should  be 
of  age— hoping  that  if  they  were  saved 
from  the  hands  of  the  laity  until  that  time, 
Edward  might  be  persuaded  to  apply  the 
revenues  to  the  relief  of  the  poor  paro- 
chial clergy;  but  the  archbishop's  exer- 
tions were  unsuccessful. 

CHAPEL.  In  former  times,  when  the 
kings  of  France  were  engaged  in  wars, 
they  always  carried  St.  Martin's  cope 
(cappa)  into  the  field,  which  was  kept  as  a 
precious  relic,  in  a  tent  where  mass  was 
said,  and  thence  the  place  was  called 
capella,  the  chapel.  There  is  however 
much  doubt  about  this  derivation.  (See 
Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  i.  341.)  The  word  was 
gradually  applied  to  any  consecrated  place 
of  prayer,  not  being  the  parish  church. 

With  us  in  England  there  are  several 
sorts  of  chapels  : 

I.  Royal  chapels.  (See  Chapel  Boyal.) 
2.  Domestic  chapels,  built  by  noblemen 
for  private  worship  in  their  families.  3. 
College  chapels,  attached  to  the  different 
colleges  of  the  universities.  4.  Chapels  of 
ease,  built  for  the  ease  of  parishioners,  who 
live  at  too  great  a  distance  from  the  parish 
church,  by  the  clergy  of  which  the  ser- 
vices of  the  chapel  are  performed.  5.  Pa- 
rochial chapels,  which  differ  from  chapels 
of  ease  on  account  of  their  having  a  per- 
manent minister,  or  incumbent,  though 
they  are  in  some  degree  dependent  upon 
the  mother  church.  A  parochial  chapelry, 
with  all  parochial  rites  independent  of  the 
mother  church,  as  to  sacraments,  marriages, 
burials,  repairs,  &c,  is  called  a  reputed 
parish.  6.  Free  chapels ;  such  as  were 
founded  by  kings  of  England,  and  made 
exempt  from  episcopal  jurisdiction.  7. 
Chapels  which  adjoin  to  any  part  of  the 
church ;  such  were  formerly  built  by 
persons  of  consideration  as  burial-places. 
To  which  may  be  added  chapels  of  corpo- 
rations, societies,  and  eleemosynary  founda- 
tion ;  as  the  mayor's  chapel  at  Bristol, 
&c.,  the  chapels  of  the  inns  of  court, 
of  hospitals,  almshouses  and  colleges.  Some 
of  these  are  exempt  from  episcopal  jurisdic- 
tion ;  and  school  chapels  from  any  right  of 
interference  by  the  incumbent  of  the  parish 
by  32  &  33  Vict.  c.  86,  and  34  &  35  Vict. 
C.66. 

II.  The  word  chapel  in  foreign  countries 
frequently  means  the  choir  or  chancel. 
This    may  possibly    be  the    meaning   in- 


CHAPEL 

tended  in  the  rubric  preceding  Morning 
Prayer,  directing  the  Morning  and  Even- 
ing Prayers  to  be  used  in  the  accustomed 
place  of  the  church,  chapel,  or  chancel. 
It  may  allude  to  the  college  chapels,  or 
such  collegiate,  chapels  as  St.  George's  at 
Windsor,  or  to  the  usage  of  some  cathedrals, 
of  having  early  morning  prayer  (as  at 
Gloucester,  &c.)  in  the  Lady  chapel,  or 
late  evening  prayer  (as  at  Durham)  in  the 
Galilee  chapel.  Henry  VIl.'s  chapel  at 
Westminster  was,  at  least  in  the  reign  of 
Queen  Elizabeth,  used  for  this  purpose.  In 
mediseval  documents  the  word  "capella" 
often  signifies  the  furniture  required  by 
a  priest  for  divine  service,  Le.  vestments, 
eucharistic  vessels,  &c. 

CHAPELS,  PEOPEIETAET.  What 
are  called  "  proprietary  chapels  "  in  London, 
and  a  few  large  towns,  are  not  consecrated, 
and  are  really  no  more  chapels  than  any 
"church  school,"  in  which  the  bishop 
licenses  a  clergyman  to  perform  service 
with  the  consent  of  the  incumbent  of  the 
parish,  for  he  cannot  do  so  without,  how- 
ever much  everybody  else  may  wish  it. 
That  is  the  true  and  legal  meaning  of  what 
people  call  the  "  parochial  system."  It  is 
curious  that  that  power  of  licensing — not 
chapels,  but  clergymen  to  do  duty  there — 
grew  up  without  any  express  legal  autho- 
rity ;  and  it  has  several  times  been  de- 
cided that  the  bishop  has  an  absolute  right 
to  revoke  such  licences,  which  do  not  con- 
stitute a  curacy,  and  therefore  there  is  no 
appeal  to  the  Archbishop  against  the  revoca- 
tion. A  clergyman  is  guilty  of  an  ecclesi- 
astical offence  and  may  be  punished  if  he 
persists  in  acting  there  after  the  licence  is 
revoked.  The  Act  of  18  &  19  Vict.  c.  86, 
does  not  supersede  the  necessity  for  a  licence 
from  the  bishop,  though  it  does  not  mention 
it.  It  was  decided  in  MacAlUster  v.  Bishop 
of  Rochester  (L.  R.  5  C.  P.  200)  that  the 
mere  building  and  consecration  of  a  chapel 
does  not  make  it  a  "chapel  of  ease"  in 
which  the  incumbent  has  a  right,  and  by 
Bishop  of  Winchester  v.  Rugg  (2  P.  C.  223) 
the  obligation,  to  perform  service,  though  he 
retains  the  right  to  prevent  any  other 
clergyman  from  doing  so:  nor  has  he  the 
patronage  by  the  mere  efiect  of  consecra- 
tion. An  incumbent  is  not  compellable  to 
keep  up  the  service  in  any  certainly  uncon- 
secrated  chapel  however  long  it  may  have 
been  continued.  Very  long  continuance 
may  however  raise  a  sufficient  presumption 
of  consecration.  The  Dissenters'  Marriage 
Act  6  &  7  W.  IV.  c.  85,  s.  26,  contains  a  kind 
of  recognition  of  "  chapels  duly  licensed  for 
the  performance  of  divine  service:"  which 
is  a  wrong  term,  for  there  is  no  such  thing,  as 
stated  above,  the  licence  being  personal.  [G.] 

CHAPEL  ROYAL.     The  chapel  royal 


CHAPLAIN 

is  under  the  government  of  the  dean  of  the 
chapel,  and  not  within  the  jurisdiction  of 
any  bishop.  But  the  archbishop  is  the 
first  chaplain  and  parochus  of  the  sove- 
reign. The  deanery  was  an  office  of  ancient 
standing;  in  the  court,  but  discontinued  in 
1572,  till  King  James's  accession,  then  it 
was  revived  in  the  person  of  Dr.  Montague. 
— Heylin's  Life  of  Lavd.  Next  to  the 
dean  is  the  subdean,  who  has  the  special 
care  of  the  chapel  service;  a  clerk  of  the 
court,  with  his  deputies,  a  prelate  or  clergy- 
man, whose  office  it  is  to  attend  the  sove- 
reign at  Divine  service,  and  to  wait  on  her 
in  her  private  oratory.  There  are  forty- 
eight  chaplains  in  ordinary,  who  "  wait "  four 
in  each  month,  and  preach  on  Sundays  and 
holidays ;  to  read  Divine  service  when  re- 
quired on  week-days,  and  to  say  grace  in 
the  absence  of  the  clerk  of  the  closet.  The 
other  officers  are,  a  confessor  of  the  house- 
hold, now  called  chaplain  of  the  household, 
who  has  the  pastoral  care  of  the  royal 
household ;  ten  priests  in  ordinary  (whose 
duties  are  like  those  of  chaplains,  or  vicars 
in  cathedrals);  sixteen  gentlemen  of  the 
chapel,  who  with  ten  choristers  now  form 
the  choir ;  and  other  officers.  The  officiat- 
ing members  of  the  chapel  royal  were 
formerly  much  more  numerous  than  now; 
thus  there  were  thirty-two  gentlemen  of  the 
chapel  in  King  Edward  VI.'s  reign,  and 
twenty-three  in  King  James  I.'s.  The 
priests  in  ordinary,  properly  speaking,  form 
part  of  the  choir.  In  strictness  this  estab- 
lishment is  ambulatory,  and  ought  to  ac- 
company the  sovereign,  of  which  practice 
we  have  many  proofs  in  ancient  records. 
The  chapels  royal  now  existing  in  England 
are  St.  George's,  Windsor,  and  in  London 
St.  James',  Whitehall,  and  the  Savoy. 

CHAPLAIN.  A  person  authorised  to 
officiate  in  the  chapels  of  the  queen,  or  in 
the  private  oratories  of  noblemen,  or  col- 
leges or  public  institutions.  The  name 
is  derived  from  capella;  the  priests  who 
superintend  the  capella  being  called  Oapel- 
lani.  According  to  a  statute  of  Henry 
VIIL,  the  persons  vested  with  a  power  of 
retaining  chaplains,  together  with  the  num- 
ber each  is  allowed  to  qualify,  are  as  fol- 
low :  "  an  archbishop,  eight ;  a  duke  or 
bishop,  six ;  marquis  or  earl,  five ;  viscount, 
four;  baron,  knight  of  the  garter,  or  lord 
chancellor,  three;  a  duchess,  marchioness, 
countess,  baroness,  the  treasurer  or  comp- 
troller of  the  king's  household,  clerk  of  the 
closet,  the  king's  secretary,  dean  of  the 
chapel,  almoner,  and  master  of  the  rolls, 
each  of  them,  two  ;  chief  justice  of  the 
King's  Bench,  and  warden  of  the  Cinque 
Ports,  each,  one."  'In  England  there  are 
forty-eight  chaplains  to  the  queen,  as 
above  mentioned.      Clergymen    who    offi- 


CHAPLAIN 


15^ 


elate  in  the  army  and  navy,  in  the  gaols, 
public  hospitals,  and  workhouses,  are  called 
chaplains.  Chaplain  is  also  a  comprehen- 
sive name,  apphed,  more  rarely  in  England 
than  abroad,  to  the  members  of  cathedrals 
and  collegiate  churches  and  chapels,  who 
are  responsible  for  the  daily  service.  In  a 
few  instances  it  is  applied  to  the  superior 
members.  Thus  at  Lichfield,  there  were 
five  capellani  principales,  major  canons, 
whose  office  it  was  to  serve  at  the  great 
altar,  rule  the  choir,  &c.,  (Dugd.  Mon.  ed. 
1830,  vi.  1257,)  and  at  Winchester  college 
the  ten  fellows  are  called,  in  the  original 
charter,  "  capellani  perpetui ; "  in  contra- 
distinction to  the  capellani  conductitii,  or 
remotivi  ; — and  the  principal  duty  of  these 
chaplain-fellows  was  to  officiate  in  the 
chapel.  But  in  general,  a  chaplain  signi- 
fied a  minister  of  the  church  of  inferior 
rank,  a  substitute  for  and  coadjutor  of  the 
canons  in  chanting,  and  in  the  performance 
of  the  Divine  offices.  (See  Dictionnaire  de 
droit  canonique,  par  Durand  de  Maillane, 
Lyons,  1787.)  They  were  so  called  from 
serving  in  the  capella  or  choir,  at  the 
various  offices,  and  in  the  various  side 
chapels,  in  contradistinction  to  the  capitular 
canons,  whose  peculiar  privilege  it  was  to 
serve  at  the  great  altar.  Under  the  name 
of  chaplain,  were  included  minor  canons,, 
vicars  choral,  and  similar  officers,  who  had 
a  variety  of  designations  abroad,  unknown 
to  us,  such  as  porticuristi,  demi-canons, 
semi-prebendaries,  &c.,  &c. 

The  name  of  chaplain,  in  its  choral  sense, 
is  retained  with  us  only  at  Christ  Church 
Oxford,  Manchester,  and  the  colleges  at  the 
universities.  At  the  latter,  they  are  fre- 
quently styled  in  the  old  charters,  capellani 
conductitii  or  remotivi ;  by  which  is  to  be 
understood,  that  they  were  originally,  at 
least,  intended  to  be  mere  stipendiaries, 
adjuncts  to  the  foundation ;  as  contrasted 
with  those  who  have  a  permanent,  corporate 
interest,  or  an  endowment  in  fee ;  like  the 
prsebendati  in  the  foreign  cathedrals,  or  the 
incorporated  vicars  choral  in  our  own  cathe- 
drals. (See  College,  Prebendary,  and  Vicars 
Choral.')  The  chaplains  at  Cambridge  and 
Eton  were  till  lately  called  conducti,  though 
originally  they  were  designated,  as  at 
Oxford,  capellani  conductitii.  Before  the 
Eeformation  the  capellani  to  be  found  in 
many  of  the  old  cathedrals  were  exclusive 
of  the  vicars  choral,  and  were  chanting 
priests.  These  sometimes  formed  corpora- 
tions or  colleges.  Abroad,  the  chaplains  in 
~many  places  discharged  both  the  duties  of 
chanting  priests  and  vicars  choral,  or  minor 
canons ;  each  having  his  separate  chapel  for 
daily  mass ;  but  all  being  obliged  to  unite 
in  discharging  the  Divine  offices,  at  least 
at  matins  and  vespers  in  the  great  choirs. 


158 


CHAPTER 


CHAPTER.  (See  Bihle.)  The  word  is 
derived  from  the  Latin  caput,  head;  and 
signifies  one  of  the  principal  divisions  of  a 
book,  and,  in  reference  to  the  Bible,  one 
of  the  larger  sections  into  which  its  books 
are  divided.  This  division,  as  well  as  that 
consisting  of  verses,  was  introduced  to  fa- 
cilitate reference,  and  not  to  indicate  any- 
natural  or  accurate  division  of  the  subjects 
treated  in  the  books. 

CH APTE  R.  (See  Dean  and  Cliapter  and 
Cathedral.)  I.  "A  chapter  of  a  cathedral 
church  consists  of  persons  ecclesiastical, 
canons  and  prebendaries,  whereof  the  dean 
is  chief,  all  subordinate  to  the  bishop,  to 
whom  they  are  as  assistants  in  matters  re- 
lating to  the  Church,  for  the  better  ordering 
and  disposing  the  things  thereof  and  for  con- 
firmation of  such  leases  of  the  temporalities 
and  offices  relating  to  the  bishopric,  as  the 
bishop  from  time  to  time  shall  happen  to 
make.  And  they  are  termed  by  the 
canonists  capitulum,  being  a  kind  of  Itmd, 
instituted  not  only  to  assist  the  bishop  .in 
manner  aforesaid,  but  also  anciently  to  rule 
and  govern  the  diocese  in  the  time  of  vaca- 
tion."— Cod.  56.  The  old  Cambridge  CopMi, 
which  had  a  veto  on  all  University  "graces" 
or  votes,  was  evidently  another  form  of  the 
word  Chapter  or  Capitulum. 

II.  Of  these  chapters,  some  are  ancient, 
some  new.  In  cathedrals  of  the  old  founda- 
tion chapters  are  of  two  kinds,  the  greater 
and  the  lesser.  The  greater  chapter  con- 
sists of  all  the  major  canons  and  prebend- 
^■uies,  whether  residentiary  or  not ;  and  their 
privileges  are  now  considered  to  be  limited 
to  the  election  of  a  bishop,  of  proctors  in 
convocation,  and  in  some  cases  they  vote  on 
the  patronage  of  the  chapter;  the  lesser 
chapter  consists  of  the  dean  and  residentia- 
ries,  who  have  the  management  of  the  chapter 
property,  and  the  ordinary  government  of 
,the  cathedral.  This,  however,  has  been  the 
growth  of  later  ages :  as  it  is  certain  that  all 
prebendal  members  had  a  voice  in  matters 
which  concerned  the  interests  of  the  cathedral 
church.  The  new  chapters  are  those  eight 
which  were  founded  or  re-modelled  by  King 
Henry  VIII.  in  the  places  of  abbots  and 
convents,  or  priors  and  convents,  which 
were  chapters  whilst  they  stood ;  or  they  are 
those  which  were  annexed  to  the  five  new 
bishoprics  founded  by  King  Henry  VIIF. 

The  chapter  of  a '  collegiate  church  is 
more  properly  called  the  college :  as  at  West- 
minster and  Windsor,  where  there  is  no 
episcopal  see. 

III.  There  may  be  a  chapter  without  any 
dean ;  as  the  former  chapter  of  the  collegiate 
church  of  Southwell :  and  grants  by  or  to 
them  are  as  effectual  as  other  grants  by 
dean    and    chapter.       In    the    cathedral 

•churches  of  St.  David's  and  Llandafif,  there 


CHASUBLE 

used  to  be  no  dean,  but  they  are  now  placed 
ou  the  same  footing  as  other  cathedrals. 

The  word  cliapter  is  occasionally  applied 
abroad  to  boards  of  universities  or  other  cor- 
porations. 

The  assemblies  of  the  knights  of  the  or- 
ders of  chivalry  (as  of  the  Garter,  Bath,  &c.) 
are  also  called  chapters. 

CHAPTER  HOUSE.  The  part  of  a 
cathedral  in  which  the  dean  and  chapter 
meet  for  business.  Until  the  thirteenth 
century,  the  chapter  house  was  always 
rectangular.  Early  in  that  century  it  be- 
came multagonal,  and  occasionally  round, 
and  the  roof  generally  supported  by  a  central 
shaft,  and  so  continued  to  the  latest  date  at 
which  any  such  building  has  been  erected. 
The  greatest  cost  was  expended  on  the  de- 
coration of  the  chapter  house,  and  there  is 
little  even  in  the  choirs  of  our  cathedrals  of 
greater  beauty  than  such  chapter  houses  as 
Lincoln,  Salisbury,  Southwell,  WeUs,  West- 
minster, Worcester,  Lichfield,  Howden,  and 
the  most  beautiful  of  all,  York,  which  has 
no  central  pillar.  Those  at  Durham  and 
Canterbury  are  or  were  magnificent  long 
rooms,  but  Durham  was  half  destroyed  in 
the  last  centm-y.  That  of  old  St.  Paul's,  in 
London,  to  judge  by  the  plates  in  Dugdale's 
History  of  St.  Paul's,  must  have  been  very 
beautiful.  It  stood  in  an  unique  position,  in 
the  centre  of  a  cloister.  It  is  now  a  house 
in  the  street  north  of  the  cathedral.  For 
the  plan  of  the  chapter  house,  in  the  arrange- 
ment of  the  conventual  buMings,  see  Mona- 
stery. Some  have  imagined  that  the  idea 
of  the  circular  or  polygonal  chapter  houses 
was  derived  from  the  circular  baptisteries 
abroad.     [G.] 

CHARGE.  This  is  the  address  delivered 
by  a  bishop,  or  archdeacon,  at  a  visitation 
of  the  clergy  under  his  jurisdiction.  (See 
Visitation ;  Archdeacon.') 

CHARLES  I.,  MARTYRDOM  OP.  The 
30th  of  January  was  appointed  a  holy  day, 
in  commemoration  of  this  event  at  the 
Restoration,  and  a  special  service  was  ap- 
pointed. The  observance  however  was 
abolished  by  Royal  order  in  1859,  and 
the  service  removed  from  the  Prayer  Book. 
(See  State  Services.) 

CARTA  CORNUTIANA.  (See  Comes  of 
St.  Jerome.) 

CHARTREUX.     (See  Carthusians.) 

CHASUBLE.  (Casula.)  The  dress  for- 
merly worn  over  the  albe  by  the  priest  in 
the  service  of  the  altar,  but  not  generally 
now  used  in  the  English  Church,  though  it 
was  prescribed  under  the  title  of  Vestment, 
in  the  rubric  of  King  Edward  VI.'s  First 
Book,  to  be  worn  by  the  priest  or  bishop 
when  celebrating  the  communion.  In  the 
time  of  the  primitive  Church,  the  Roman 
toga  was  becoming  disused,  and  the  pa3nula 


CHEUUB 

■was  taking  its  place.  The  pajnula  formed  a 
perfect  circle,  with  an  aperture  to  admit  the 
head  in  the  centre,  while  it  fell  down  so  as 
•completely  to  envelope  the  person  of  the 
wearer.  The  casula  appears  to  have  been 
identical  with  the  pmnula  and  is  described 
by  St.  Isidore  of  Seville,  c.  600  a.d.  (De 
Origin,  xix.  c.  21),  as  "  a  garment  furnished 
with  a  hood  (vestis  cucuUata)  and  is  a 
■diminutive  of  "  casa, "  a  cottage,  seeing  that, 
like  a  little  hut,  it  covers  the  entire  person." 
A  short  pasnula  was  more  common,  and  a 
longer  for  the  higher  orders ;  it  was  this  last 
which  was  used  by  the  clergy,  both  at  first 
as  an  outdoor  garment  (^Acta  Sanct.  Augusti. 
d.  xsvii.  tom.  vi.  "  Caisarii  Vita  ")  and  after- 
wards exclusively  in  their  ser'vices.  The 
Eomish  Church  has  altered  it  much  by 
cutting  it  away  literally,  so  as  to  expose  the 
.arms,  and  leave  only  a  straight  piece  before 
and  behind.  The  Greek  Church  retains  it 
in  its  primitive  shape,  under  the  title  of  <f>ai- 
foXtov,  or  (jievoiXiov :  the  old  brasses  in  Eng- 
land also  show  the  same  form,  some  even 
«ince  the  Eeformation.  And  many  tombs 
■of  bishops  in  the  thirteenth  century,  and 
later,  show  it  in  a  graceful  and  flowing  form. 
(See  "  Vestiarum  Ghristianum,"  by  Eev. 
W.  B.  Marriott.) 

CHERUB,  or  (the  plural)  CHERUBIM, 
a  particular  order  of  angels.  When  God 
■drove  Adam  and  Eve  out  of  Paradise,  "  he 
placed  at  the  east  of  the  garden  of  Eden 
cherubims,  and  a  flaming  sword  which 
turned  every  way,  to  keep  the  way  of  the 
tree  of  life."  (Gen.  iii.  24.)  When  Moses 
was  commanded  by  God  to  make  the  ark  of 
the  covenant  with  the  propitiatory,  or 
mercy-seat,  he  was  (Exod.  xxv.  19,  20)  to 
make  one  cherub  on  the  one  end,  and 
•another  cherub  on  the  other  end;  but  Moses 
has  left  us  in  the  dark  as  to  the  form  of 
these  cherubims.  The  Jews  suppose  them 
to  have  been  in  the  shape  of  young  men, 
•with  wings ;  and  the  generality  of  inter- 
preters, both  ancient  and  modem,  suppose 
them  to  have  had  human  shapes.  But  it  is 
■certain  that  the  prophet  Ezekiel  (i.  10,  and 
X.  14)  represents  them  quite  otherwise,  and 
speaks  of  the  face  of  a  cherub  as  synonymous 
with  that  of  an  ox  or  calf;  and  in  the 
Kevelation  (iv.  6)  they  -are  called  f£a, 
ieasts.  Josephus  (Antiq.  lib.  iii.)  says  that 
they  were  a  kind  of  ■winged  creatures, 
answering  to  the  description  of  those  which 
Moses  saw  about  the  throne  of  God,  but  the 
Jike  to  which  no  man  had  ever  seen  before. 
Grotius,  Bochart,  and  other  learned  moderns, 
deriving  the  word  from  charab,  which  in 
the  Chaldee,  Syriac,  and  Arabic,  signifies  to 
plough,  make  no  difficulty  to  suppose  that 
the  cherubim  here  spoken  of  resembled  an 
ox,  either  in  whole  or  in  part.  But  it  is 
not  necessary  to  dwell   on  fanciful  ideas 


CHILIASTS 


159 


with  regard  to  the  appearance  of  the 
cherubim,  which  may  be  found  in  Park- 
hurst's  Lexicon. 

It  is  certainly  derogatory  to  right  ideas  of 
religion,  to  suppose  that  these  mysterious 
symbols  were  derived  from  the  images  of 
heathen  idolatry,  in  order  to  indulge  the 
prejudices  of  the  Israelites.  It  is  more 
consistent  and  probable  to  believe  that  the 
corresponding  symbols  of  Egyptians  and 
Assyrians  (the  latter  so  wonderfully  illus- 
trated by  the  late  discoveries  at  Nineveh) 
were  derived  from  patriarchal  traditions; 
distortions  of  that  pure  worship  of  God 
which  was  derived  to  the  whole  world  from 
Noah.  This  solution  will  account  for  many 
of  those  extraordinary  resemblances  which 
may  be  traced  between  heathen  and  Jewish 
customs.  By  many  it  has  been  considered 
that  the  four  symbols,  applied  from  very 
ancient  times  to  the  four  evangelists,  are 
derived  from  the  cherubic  figures. 

CHERUBIC  HYMN.  A  title  sometimes 
given  to  the  Tersanctus  or  Trisagion.  (See 
Tersanctus.) 

CHILIASTS,  or  MILLENARIAKS. 
(See  Millennium.')  A  school  of  Christians 
who  believe  that,  after  the  general  or  last 
judgment,  the  saints  shall  live  a  thousand 
years  upon  earth,  and  enjoy  all  manner  of 
innocent  satisfaction.  It  is  thought  Papias, 
bishop  of  Hierapolis,  who  lived  in  the  second 
century,  and  was  disciple  to  St.  John  the 
evangelist,  or,  as  some  others  think,  to 
John  the  Elder,  was  the  first  who  main- 
tained this  opinion.  The  authority  of  this 
bishop,  supported  by  some  passages  in  the 
Revelation,  brought  a  great  many  of  the 
primitive  fathers  to  embrace  his  persuasion, 
as  Irenajus,  Justin  Martyr,  aud  Tertullian ; 
and  afterwards  Nepos,  an  Egyptian  bishop, 
living  in  the  third  century,  was  so  far 
engaged  in  this  belief,  and  maintained  it 
mth  so  much  elocution,  that  Dionysius, 
bishop  of  Alexandria,  thought  himself 
obliged  to  write  against  him :  upon  which 
Coracion,  one  of  the  principal  abettors  of 
this  doctrine,  renounced  it  publicly,  which 
practice  was  followed  by  the  generality  of 
the  West.  The  Millenarians  were  in  like 
manner  condemned  by  Pope  Damasus,  in  a 
synod  held  at  Rome  against  the  Apolli- 
narians.  (Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  192.)  Some 
of  the  modern  Millenarians  have  refined  the 
notion  of  Cerinthus,  and  made  the  satis- 
factions rational  and  angelical,  untainted 
with  anything  of  sensuality  or  Epicui-ism. 
As  for  the  time  of  this  thousand  years, 
those  that  hold  this  opinion  are  not  per- 
fectly agreed.  Mr.  Mede  makes  it  to 
commence  and  determine  before  the  general 
conflagration ;  but  Dr.  Thomas  -Burnet  sup- 
poses that  this  world  will  bo  first  destroyed, 
and  that  a  new  paradisaical  earth  will  be 


160 


CHIMERE 


formed  out  of  the  ashes  of  tlie  old  one, 
where  the  saints  will  converse  together  for  a 
thousand  years,  and  then  be  translated  to  a 
higher  station. 

CHIMERE.  The  upper  robe  worn  by 
a  bishop,  to  which  the  lawn  sleeves  are 
attached.  The  name  is  probably  derived 
from  the  Italian  zimarra,  which  is  described 
as  "  vesta  talare  de'  sacerdoti  et  de'  chierici." 
— Palmer. 

Hody  says  that  before  the  Reformation, 
and  in  the  reigns  of  Henry  VIII.  and 
Edward  VI.,  the  bishops  wore  their  Doctor 
of  Divinity  scarlet  habit  with  their  rochet, 
the  colour  being  changed  for  the  black  satin 
chimere  late  in  the  time  of  Queen  Elizabeth. 
The  chimere  seems  to  resemble  the  garment 
used  by  bishops  during  the  middle  ages, 
and  called  mantellefum ;  which  was  a  sort 
of  cope,  with  apertures  for  the  arms  to 
pass  through.  (See  Du  Gauge's  Glossary.) 
The  scarlet  chimere  strongly  resembles  the 
scarlet  habit  worn  in  congregation,  and  at 
St.  Mary's,  by  doctors  at  O.'^ford  and  Cam- 
bridge. Some  have  supposed  that  our 
episcopal  dress  is  in  fact  merely  a  doctorial 
habit.  Perhaps  however  the  origin  of  both 
the  chimere,  the  Oxford  habit,  and  the 
Cambridge  doctorial  cope  and  gown,  and 
the  episcopal  mantelletum,  may  all  be 
derived  from  the  dalmatic  or  tunicle  (see 
Dalmatic),  which  was  formerly  a  charac- 
teristic part  of  the  dress  of  bishops  and 
deacons  :  from  which  the  chimere  differs  in 
being  open  in  front.  The  sewing  of  the 
lawn  sleeves  to  the  chimere  is  a  modern 
innovation.  They  ought  properly  to  be 
fastened  to  the  rochet. 

CHOIR,  or  QUIRE.  This  word  has 
two  meanings.  The  first  is  identical  with 
chancel  (see  Chancel),  signifying  the  place 
which  the  ministers  of  Divine  worship  oc- 
cupj',  or  ought  to  occupy.  The  word,  ac- 
cording to  Isidore,  is  derived  from  chorus 
circumstantium,  because  the  clergy  stood 
round  the  altar. 

I.  There  were  three  divisions  in  a  church, 
the  sanctuary,  or  presbytery,  (hema)  the 
choir,  and  the  nave,  but  with  regard  to  the 
distinction  between  the  sanctuary  and  choir, 
there  is  considerable  difiSculty.  In  an  an- 
cient coimcil  it  was  ordered  "  Sacerdotes 
ante  altare  communicant,  in  choro  clerus, 
extra  chorum  populus  "  (Oonc.  I'olet.  iv.  c. 
18.) 

It  seems  most  probable,  however,  that 
the  chief  division  was  between  the  choir 
and  nave;  and  that  there  were  the  cancelli, 
or  rails  of  wood.  St.  Jerome  forbade  the 
Emperor  Theodosius  to  communicate  within 
the  choir,  and  a  similar  strictness  seems  to 
have  been  observed  in  some,  churches  for  a 
considerable  period  (Theodor.  lib.  v.  o.  15  ; 
Soz.  lib.  vii.  c.  25 ;   Cone.  Trull,  c.  69  ;  see 


CHOIR 

also  Eus.  lib.  x.  c.  4.)  But  there  were- 
different  customs  in  diflferent  places.  In 
the  third  century  in  Alexandria  we  read  of 
men  and  women  standing  at  the  Holy  Table 
and  receiving  the  Eucharist  there ;  and  in 
France  lay  persons  were  certainly  admitted 
into  the  choir  to  communicate,  though  at 
other  times  they  were  forbidden  entrance — 
Dionys.  op.  Kuseb.  lib.  vii.  c.  9 ;  Cone.  Turon. 
ii.  c.  4. 

At  the  eastern  end  of  the  choir,  or  chancel, 
there  was  often  an  apse  (conchula  hematis), 
and  this  may  have  given  rise  to  the  mention 
of  three  divisions  in  a  church,  as  above. 
(See  Apse.) 

Custom  has  in  later  times  usually  re- 
stricted the  name  of  chancel  to  parish 
churches,  that  of  choir  to  cathedrals,  and 
such  churches  or  chapels  as  are  collegiate. 
In  the  choirs  of  cathedrals  (see  Cathedral)^ 
which  are  very  large,  the  congregation  also 
sometimes  assemble ;  but  the  clergy  and 
other  members  of  the  foundation  occupy  the 
seats  on  each  side  -(which  are  called  stalls), 
according  to  the  immemorial  custom  of  all 
Christian  countries.— Du  Cange's  Glossary ; 
Diet.  Christ.  Antiq. 

II.  The  second,  but  more  proper  sense  of 
the  word,  is,  a  body  of  men  set  apart  for 
the  performance  of  all  the  services  of  the 
Church,  in  the  most  solemn  form.  Pro- 
perly speaking,  the  whole  corporate  body  of 
a  cathedral,  including  capitular  and  lay 
members,  forms  the  choir ;  and  in  this  ex- 
tended sense  ancient  writers  frequently 
used  the  word.  Thus  the  "  glorious  com- 
pany of  the  apostles "  is  called  in  Latin 
"apostolorum  chorus."  The  choir  is  used 
in  some  very  ancient  documents  for  the- 
cathedral  chapter.  But,  in  its  more  re- 
stricted sense,  we  are  to  understand  that 
body  of  men  and  boys  who  form  a  part  of 
the  foundation  of  these  places,  and  whose 
special  duty  it  is  to  perform  the  service  to 
music.  The  choir  properly  consists  of 
the  precentor,  the  priest  vicars  or  minor 
canons,  lay  vicars  or  singing  men,  and 
boys ;  and  should  have  at  least  six  men  an4 
six  boys  at  every  week-day  service,  these 
being  essential  to  the  due  performance  of 
the  chants,  services,  and  anthems.  Every 
choir  is  divided  into  two  parts,  stationed  on 
each  side  of  the  chancel,  in  order  to  sing 
alternately  the  verses  of  the  psalms  and 
hymns,  one  side  answering  the  other.  (See 
Deeani;  Cantoris.) 

In  the  first  Prayer  Book  of  King  Edward 
VI.,  the  rubric  at  the  beginning  of  the 
morning  prayer  ordered  the  priests,  "  being 
in  the  quire,  to  begin  the  Lord's  Prayer  ;"■ 
so  that  it  was  the  custom  of  the  minister  to 
perform  Divine  service  at  the  upper  end  of 
the  chancel  near  the  altar.  Against  this, 
Buoer,  hj'  the  direction  of  Calvin,  made  a 


CHOEBPISCOPI 

great  outcry,  pretending  "  it  was  an  anti- 
christiau  practice  for  the  priest  to  say 
prayers  only  in  the  choir,  a  place  peculiar 
to  the  clergy,  and  not  in  the  body  of  the 
church  among  the  people,  who  had  as  much 
right  to  Divine  worship  as  the  clergy." 
This  occasioned  an  alteration  of  the  rubric, 
when  the  Common  Prayer  Book  was  revised 
in  the  fifth  year  of  King  Edward,  and  it  was 
ordered,  that  prayers  should  be  said  in  such 
part  of  the  church  "  where  the  people  might 
best  hear."  At  the  accession  of  Queen 
Elizabeth,  the  ancient  practice  was  restored, 
but  with  a  dispensing  power  left  in  the 
ordinary,  of  determining  it  otherwise  if 
he  saw  just  cause.  Convenience  prevailed, 
so  that  the  prayers  were  very  commonly 
read  in  the  body  of  the  church,  and  in 
those  parish  churches  where  the  service 
was  read  in  the  chancel,  the  minister's  place 
was  at  the  lower  end  of  it.  In  Oriffin 
V.  Dighton  (1864),  Lord  C.  J.  Erie  decided 
that  the  chancel  is  the  place  appointed  for 
the  clergyman,  and  those  who  assist  him 
in  Divine  service,  subject  to  the  jurisdiction 
of  the  ordinary.    [H.] 

CHOEEPISCOPI.  (Country  bishops, 
Xapeiria'K.oTToi,  Episcopi  rurales,  called  also 
villani  or  vicani  episcopi,  as  opposed  to 
eathedrales  episcopi.)  They  are  mentioned 
in  the  councils  of  Anoyra,  Neo-Caesarea, 
Ephesus  (a.d.  314:),  and  of  Nice,  when 
fifteen  were  present. 

Some  considerable  difference  of  opinion 
has  existed  relative  to  the  true  ministerial 
order  of  the  chorepiscopi,  some  contending 
that  they  were  mere  presbyters,  among 
whom  are  Morinus  and  Du  Cange,  others 
that  they  were  a  mixed  body  of  presbyters 
and  bishops,  as  Bellarmine,  and  a  third  class 
that  they  were  all  invested  with  the  au- 
thority of  the  episcopal  office.  That  the 
latter  opinion,  however,  is  the  correct  one, 
is  maintained  by  Bishop  Barlow,  Dr.  Ham- 
mond, Beveridge,  Cave,  and  other  eminent 
divines  of  the  English  Church,  together  with 
Bingham,  in  his  "  Antiquities  of  the  Christian 
Church "  (ii.  xiv).  Their  origin  seems  to 
have  arisen  from  a  desire  on  the  part  of  the 
city  or  diocesan  bishops  to  supply  the 
churches  of  the  neighbouring  country  with 
more  episcopal  services  than  they  could 
conveniently  render.  Some  of  the  best 
quaUfied  presbyters  were  therefore  conse- 
crated bishops,  and  thus  empowered  to  act 
in  the  stead  of  the  principal  bishop,  though 
in  strict  subordination  to  his  authority. 
Hence,  we  find  them  at  first  ordaining 
presbyters  and  deacons  undet  the  licence  of 
the  city  bishop ;  and  confirmation  was  one 
of  their  ordinary  duties.  This,  however, 
was  afterwards  stopped,  for  in  the  council  of 
Antioch  it  was  ordered  that  they  /i^i-f  jrpf  o- 
^vrepov,  fifjTe  Siclkovov  x"P<"'<"'«'«'  ToKpav : 


CHOEEUT.aE 


161 


though  they  might  make  readers,  sub- 
deacons  and  the  like.  (Gone.  Antioch.  c. 
10.)  Letters  dimissory  were  also  given  to 
the  country  clergy  by  the  chorepiscopi,  and 
they  had  the  privilege  of  sitting  and 
voting  in  synods  and  councils.  The  dif- 
ference between  the  chorepiscopus  and 
what  was,  at  a  later  period,  denominated 
a  suffragan,  is  scarcely  appreciable,  both 
being  limited  to  the  exercise  of  their  powers 
within  certain  boundaries,  and  enjoying  only 
a  delegated  power  from  the  diocesan  during 
his  pleasure. 

The  chorepiscopi  were  at  first  confined 
to  the  Eastern  Church.  In  the  Western 
Church,  and  especially  in  France,  they  be- 
gan to  be  known  about  the  fifth  century. 
They  have  never  been  numerous  in  Spain 
and  Italy.  In  Germany  they  must  have 
been  frequent  in  the  seventh  and  eighth 
centuries.  In  the  East,  the  order  was 
nominally  abolished  by  the  Council  of  Lao- 
dicea,  a.d.  361.  But  so  little  respect  was 
entertained  for  this  decree,  that  the  order 
continued  until  the  tenth  century.  They 
were  first  prohibited  in  the  Western  Church 
in  the  ninth  century;  but,  according  to 
some  writers,  they  continued  in  Franco 
until  the  twelfth  century,  when  the  arro- 
gance, insubordination,  and  injurious  con- 
duct of  this  class  of  ecclesiastics  became  a 
subject  of  general  complaint  in  that  country. 
They  are  said  to  have  existed  in  Ireland 
until  the  thirteenth  century.  The  non- 
episcopal  functions  of  the  chorepiscopi  are 
now  in  great  part  performed  by  archdeacons 
and  rural  deans.     (See  Suffragans.) 

CHORISTER.  A  singer  in  a  choir.  As 
early  as  the  begiiming  of  the  fourth  centiury, 
there  was  an  order  of  singers  in  the  Church, 
called  cantores  or  psalmistas,  and  also  moni- 
tors or  suggestors  (ijro/SoXeTj),  their  office 
being,  first,  to  lead  the  congregation,  after- 
wards to  sing  instead  of  the  congregation. 
{Cone.  Laod.  c.  15,  24;  Can.  Apost.  c.  69; 
Constit.  Apost.  lib.  iii.,  c.  11,  &c.)  The  for- 
mer was  their  usual  duty,  until  mediseval 
times  (though  this  has  been  denied  by  more 
modem  Roman  authors) ;  and  constant  re- 
ferences are  made  to  congregational  singing 
by  Augustine,  Ambrose,  Chrysostom,  &c. 

In  some  churches  the  choristers  or  psal- 
mistjB  sang  the  first  half  of  a  verse  of  a 
psalm,  the  people  taking  up  the  second  half 
as  a  response.  (Vales,  in  Socrat.  v.  c.  22.) 
Choristers  or  singers  needed  no  ordination 
by  the  bishop,  but  might  be  appointed  by  a 
presbyter  using  this  form.  "  See  that  thou 
beHeve  in  thine  heart  what  thou  singest  with 
thy  mouth,  and- approve  in  thy  works  what 
thou  believest  in  thy  heart."  (Cone.  Gar- 
thaq.  iv.  c.  10.)    [H.] 

CHOBEUTJE.  A  sect  of  heretics,  who, 
among  other    errors,   persisted  in  keeping 


162 


CHKESTUS 


the  Sabbath  as  a  fast. — Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i. 
316. 

CHKESTUS.  CHRESTIANS.  A 
mistaken  pronunciation  of  the  name  of  our 
Lord,  and  His  followers,  by  certain  of  the 
heathen,  who  derived  it  from  xPV'"'"'' 
sweet  or  good.  It  is  noticed  by  Justin 
Martyr,  TertuUian  and  others.  (Bingham, 
bk.  i.  c.  1.)  It  has  been  supposed  that  the 
language  of  Suetonius  (^Claud.  c.  25)  in 
describing  the  expulsion  of  the  Jews  from 
Rome  by  Claudian,  indicates  the  same  con- 
fusion between  Christus  and  Chrestus. 
"  Judjeos,  impulsore  Chresto,  assidue  tumul- 
tuantes  Eoma  expulit."  The  word  Christus 
was  no  doubt  the  watchword  in  all  Jewish 
insurrections;  hence  the  notion  may  have 
arisen  that  some  person  named  Christus  or 
Chrestus  was  the  instigator  of  them. 

CHRISM.  (Xpia/ui,  oil.)  Consecrated  oil 
used  in  baptism,  confirmation,  ordination, 
and  extreme  unction. 

I.  When  the  use  of  the  chrism  first  began 
in  the  Church  is  uncertain,  but  it  was  of  very 
early  date.  Bishop  Pearson  (Led.  in  Act. 
v.)  thinks  that  if  not  of  apostolic  origin,  it- 
was  introduced  very  shortly  after  the  apos- 
tles' time,  and  it  certainly  was  in  use  in  the 
third  century,  when  it  is  mentioned  by 
Tertullian  (de  Baptismo)  and  Origen  (in 
Levit.  Horn.  ix.).  Later  writers  frequently 
mention  it,  and  they  often  refer  to  two 
unctions.  Thus  the  writer  of  the  Apostohc 
Constitutions  speaks  of  ^P'"'"'  fvariKoxi 
ikalov,  and  pfpiVii/  fivpov,  or  xplo-iia, 
— the  one  being  given  before  the  baptism, 
the  other  after.  (Constit.  vii.  c.  42  and  c.  44 ; 
see  also  Cyril.  Catech.  Myst.  ii.  §  iii. ;  Ambrose, 
de  Sacra,  i.  c.  2.)  The  first  might  be  done 
by  a  deacon,  the  person  baptized  being 
"  CJnctus  quasi  athleta  Christi"  (Chrys.  Horn. 
vi.  in  Colas. ;  Ambrose,  ut  sup.) ;  but  the 
second  was  reserved  to  the  bishop,  who  with 
it  gave  the  imposition  of  hands,  and  sign  oi 
seal  of  the  Lord — the  cross  on  the  forehead. 
This  confirmation,  and  attendant  unction, 
was  generally  administered  at  the  same 
time  as  baptism,  but  if  the  bishop  should 
be  absent,  it  was  to  be  deferred  as  short  a 
time  as  possible. — Const.  Apost.  vii.  43,  44 ; 
St.  Jerome,  cont.  Lucifer,  c.  4,  &c. 

When  baptism  and  confirmation  were 
separated,  the  chrism  was  attached  to  each. 
The  priest  might  anoint,  if  the  chrism  had 
been  consecrated  by  a  bishop  :  but  he  might 
not  lay  on  hands. — Innoc.  Ep.  ad  Decent,  c.  3. 

The  imction  with  the  chrism  at  ordination 
appears  first  in  the  Sacramentary  of  Gelasius. 
— Morin.  267. 

The  custom  of  anointing  the  sick  with  oil 
is  scriptural,  and  observed  generally  by  the 
Church  till  the  Reformation.  But  the  Roman 
Church  exalted  it  to  a  sacrament,  and  de- 
clared it  necessarv  to  salvation.    It  was 


CHRIST 

retained  in  the  first  Prayer  Book  of  Edward 
VI.,  but  omitted  in  the  second.  (See  Ex- 
treme Unction.') 

II.  The  chrism  originally  was  consecrated 
by  the  bishop  as  occasion  required ;  but  as 
certain  presbyters  took  upon  themselves  to 
prepare  and  consecrate  it  (a  proceeding 
which  was  forbidden  in  the  first  council  of 
Toledo)  for  convenience  sake,  it  became 
the  custom  for  the  bishops  to  consecrate  a 
quantity  of  the  unguent  on  a  fixed  day — 
Maundy-Thursday — so  that  it  should  be 
always  in  readiness.  In  the  sacramentaries 
of  Gelasius  and  of  Gregory  directions  for 
the  consecration  on  that  day  are  given ;  and 
the  blessing  of  the  chrism  is  still  one  of  the 
ceremonies  of  Maundy-Thursday  in  the 
Greek  and  Roman  Churches.  (Mignet, 
Patrol.  Ixxiv. ;  Morin.  267  ;  Bingham,  bk. 
xi.  cc.  1,  2 :  ix.  1  seg. :  bk.  xii.  1,  &c. ; 
Blunt,  Annot.  P.  B.  210,  222,  &c.)  There 
are  two  sorts  of  it ;  the  one  is  a  composition 
of  oil  and  balsam,  made  use  of  in  baptism, 
confirmation,  and  orders  ;  the  other  is  only 
plain  oil  consecrated  by  the  bishop,  and 
used  for  catechumens  and  extreme  unction. 
Chrism  has  been  discontinued  in  the  Church 
of  England  since  the  Reformation.    [H.] 

CHRISMAL,  CHEISOM  orCHRISOME. 
A  name  sometimes  used  for  a  vessel  to  hold 
the  consecrated  oil,  or  for  the  reservation  of 
the  consecrated  Host:  but  more  frequently 
for  the  piece  of  white  linen  bound  round 
the  head  of  the  newly  baptized,  to  retain 
the  "Chrism"  on  the  head,  which  the 
priest  used  to  put  upon  the  child,  saying, 
"  Take  this  white  vesture  for  a  token  of 
innocence." 

By  a  constitution  of  Edmund,  archbishop 
of  Canterbury,  a.d.  736,  the  chrisomes, 
after  having  served  the  purposes  of  baptism, 
were  to  be  made  use  of  only  for  the  making 
or  mending  of  surplices,  &c.,  or  for  the 
wrapping  of  chalices. 

The  first  Common  Prayer  Book  of  King 
Edward  orders  that  the  woman  shall  ofl'er 
the  chrisome,  when  she  comes  to  be 
churched ;  but,  if  the  child  happens  to  die 
before  her  churching,  she  was  excused  from 
ofieriug  it ;  and  it  was  customary  to  xise  it 
as  a  shroud,  and  to  wrap  the  child  in  it 
when  it  was  buried.  Hence,  by  an  abuse 
of  words,  the  term  is  now  used  not  to 
denote  children  who  die  between  the  time 
of  their  baptism  and  the  churching  of  the 
mother,  but  to  denote  children  who  die 
before  they  are  baptized,  and  so  are  in- 
capable of  Christian  burial.    [H.] 

CHRIST.  From  the  Greek  word  (XptWos) 
corresponding  with  the  Hebrew  word  Mes- 
siah, and  signifying  tJie  Anointed  One.  It 
is  given  pre-eminently  to  our  blessed  Lord 
and  Saviour  Jesus  Christ.  As  the  holy 
unction  was  given  to  kings,  priests,  and 


CHEISTEN 

prophets,  by  describing  the  promised  Sa- 
viour of  the  world  under  the  name  of  Christ, 
Anointed,  or  Messiah,  it  was  sufficient  evi- 
dence that  the  qualities  of  king,  prophet, 
and  high  priest  would  eminently  centre  in 
him;  and  that  he  would  exercise  them  noo 
only  over  the  Jews,  but  over  all  mankind, 
and  particularly  over  those  whom  he  should 
elect  into  his  Church.  Our  blessed  Saviour 
was  not,  indeed,  anointed  to  these  offices  by 
oil ;  but  he  was  anointed  by  the  power  and 
grace  of  the  Holy  Ghost,  who  visibly  de- 
scended upon  him  at  his  baj^tism.  Thus 
(Acts  X.  38)  "God  anointed  Jesus  of 
Kazareth  with  the  Holy  Ghost  and  with 
power."  See  Matt.  iii.  16,  17 ;  John  iii. 
34.     (See  Jesus  and  Messiah.) 

CHRISTEN,  TO.  To  baptize ;  because, 
at  baptism,  the  person  receiving  that  sacra- 
ment is  made,  as  the  catechism  teaches,  a 
member  of  Christ. 

CHRISTENDOM.  All  those  regions  in 
■which  the  kingdom  or  Church  of  Christ  is 
planted. 

CHRISTIAN.  The  title  given  to  those 
■who  call  upon  the  name  of  the  Lord  Jesus'. 
It  was  -at  Antioch,  ■where  St.  Pavd  and  St.^ 
Barnabas  jointly  preached  the  Christian  re- 
ligion, that  the  disciples  were  first  called 
Christians  (Acts  xi.  26),  in  the  year  of  our 
Lord  43,  probably  by  way  of  derision,  the 
inhabitants  of  Antioch  being  renowned  for 
the  invention  of  scurrilous  and  opprobrious 
names.  They  were  generally  called  by  one 
another  brethren,  faithful,  saints,  and  be- 
lievers. The  name  of  Nazarenes  was,  by 
■way  of  reproach,  given  them  by  the  Jews. 
(Acts  xxiv.  5.)  Another  name  of  reproach 
■was  that  of  Galilseans,  which  was  the  em- 
peror Julian's  style  whenever  he  spoke  of 
the  Christians.  Epiphanius  {Bxr.  39,  n.  4) 
says,  that  they  were  called  Jesseans,  either 
from  Jesse,  the  father  of  David,  or,  which  is 
more  probable,  from  the  name  of  Jesus, 
•whose  disciples  they  were.  The  word  Chris- 
tian is  used  but  three  times  in  Holy  Scrip- 
ture :  Acts  xi.  26 ;  xxvi.  28 ;  1  St.  Pet.  i  v.  16. 

CHRISTIAN  NAME.  (See  Name) 
The  name  given  to  us  when  we  are  made 
Christians,  i.e.  at  our  baptism. 

The  Scripture  history,  both  of  the  Old 
and  New  Testament,  contains  many  in- 
stances of  the  names  of  persons  being 
changed,  or  of  their  receiving  an  additional 
name,  when  they  were  admitted  into  co- 
venant with  God,  or  into  a  new  relation 
mth  our  blessed  Lord;  and  it  was  at  cir- 
cumcision, which  answered,  in  many  re- 
spects, to  baptism  in  the  Christian  Church, 
that  the  Jews  gave  a  name  to  their  chil- 
dren. This  custom  was  adopted  into  the 
Christian  Church,  and  we  find  very  ancient 
instances  of  it  recorded.  For  example, 
Thascius  Cyprian,  at  his  baptism,  changed 


CHRISTMAS 


1C3 


his  first  name  to  Ca^cilius,  out  of  respect  ior 
the  presbyter  who  was  his  spiritual  father. 
The  custom  is  still  retained,  a  name  beino- 
given  by  the  godfather  and  godmother  of 
each  child  at  baptism,  by  which  name  he  is 
addressed  by  the  minister  when  he  receives 
that  holy  sacrament.  (See  Baptismal  Ser- 
vice.") 

CHRISTIANS  OP  ST.  THOMAS.  (See 
Thomas,  St.,  Christians  of.) 

CHRISTMAS  DAY.  Festum  Nativitatis 
(French  "  Noel "  said  to  be  a  corruption  of 
natalis).  The  25th  December ;  the  day  on 
which  the  flniversal  Church  celebrates  the 
nativity  or  birthday  of  our  Lord  and  Saviour 
Jesus  Christ. 

I.  Though  there  can  be  no  doubt  that 
such  a  festival  was  held  from  the  earliest 
ages  of  Christianity,  yet  it  was  not  always 
observed  on  the  same  day.  Clement  of 
Alexandria  speaks  of  May  20  or  April  21, 
as  being  days  on  which  the  nativity  was 
celebrated.  In  the  Eastern  Church  it  was 
generally  kept  concurrently  with  the  Epi- 
phany, Jan.  6,  there  being  a  tradition  that 
our  Lord  was  baptized  on  that  day.  St. 
Chrysostom,  addressing  the  people  of  Antioch, 
says  that  ten  years  were  not  past  since  they 
came  to  the  true  knowledge  of  the  day  of 
Christ's  birth,  which  they  before  kept  on 
Epiphany  until  the  Western  Church  enlight- 
ened them  {Ham.  xxxi.  de  Natali  Christi; 
also  Horn.  xxiv.  de  Bapt.  Christ.).  Other 
Churches  followed  this  example,  but  to  this 
day  the  Armenian  Church  continues  to  cele- 
brate Christmas  and  the  Epiphany  on  Jan.  6. 
(ies  Allat.  de  Dom.  et  Bebd.  Gr.  c.  32.)  The 
observance  of  this  festival  on  Dec.  25  in  the 
Western  Church  is  most  ancient,  although  we 
may  not  give  much  belief  to  the  statement 
of  the  forged  decretal  epistles,  that  Telesi- 
phorus,  who  lived  in  the  reign  of  Antoninus 
Pius,  ordered  Divine  service  to  be  celebrated, 
and  an  angelical  hymn  to  be  sung,  the  night 
before  the  nativity.  While  the  persecution 
raged  under  Diocletian,  who  kept  his  court 
at  Nicomedia,  that  tyrant,  among  other  acts 
of  cruelty,  finding  multitudes  of  Christians 
assembled  together  to  celebrate  the  nativity 
of  Christ,  commanded  the  chiirch  doors  to 
be  shut,  and  fire  put  to  the  building,  which 
soon  reduced  them  and  the  place  to  ashes. 

The  chronological  correctness  of  keeping 
the  birthday  of  our  Lord  on  the  25th  of 
December,  has  been  demonstrated  in  a  most 
careful  analysis,  by  Dr.  Jarvis,  in  his 
Chronological  Introduction  to  the  History  of 
the  Church.  See  also  article  in  Diet,  of 
Christ.  Antiq.  p.  359. 

II.  The  festival  was  always  kept  with 
great  veneration  and  joy ;  and  the  eve  was 
also  observed  with  solemnity.  Clemens  of 
Alexandria,  quoted  above  (Strom,  lib.  i.  c. 
21),  says  of  certain  Christians  of  his  day 

M  2 


164 


CHRISTOLYTES 


that  they  spent  the  night  before  in  readings : 
and  St.  Chrysostom  bids  the  people  purge 
their  houses  before  tliey  come  and  see  our 
Lord.  The  German  name  Weilmacht  implies 
that  the  observance  of  the  festival  is  con- 
sidered to  commence  with  the  night  of 
Christmas-eve,  and  before  the  Eeformatiori 
in  the  Church  of  England  there  was  special 
service  on  the  eve,  mass  soon  after  midnight, 
another  at  cock-crow,  and  a  third  at  the 
usual  hour — ^the  first  two  being  omitted  in 
the  first  P.  B.,  the  thud  in  the  second.  All 
possible  honour  was  shown  to  the  day; 
there  were  always  sermons,  many  preached 
by  the  Fathers  being  extant;  and  solemn 
communion  (Chrys.  Horn.  xxxi.  de  Philo- 
gonis);  persons  were  ordered  to  attend  the 
chief  churches,  and  not  to  go  to  any  of 
the  lesser  churches  in  the  country  (Cone. 
Ansel,  i.  cc.  27) ;  public  games  and  shows 
were  prohibited  (Cod.  Theod.  lib.  xv.  de 
Speefacjdis ;  see  also  Naz.  Orat.  38) ;  and  it 
was  to  be  a  day  of  rest  equally  with  the 
Lord's  Day  (Const.  Apost.  viii.  33 ;  Bingham, 
XX.  civ). 

III.  In  the  First  Book  of  King  Edward, 
there  were  separate  Collects,  Epistles,  and 
Gospels  appointed  for  the  first  and  second 
communion  on  this  and  on  Easter-day.  It  is 
one  of  the  days  for  which  the  Church  of 
England  appoints  special  psalms,  and  a 
special  preface  in  the  Communion  Service : 
and  if  it  fall  on  a  Friday,  that  Friday  is 
not  to  be  a  fast  day.    [H.] 

CHBISTOLYTES.  (XpioToXirai,  separor- 
torso/  Christ.')  A  sect  in  the  sixth  century, 
which  held,  that  when  Christ  descended  into 
hell,  he  left  his  soul  and  body  there,  and 
only  rose  with  his  Divinity  to  heaven. 

CHRISTOPHORI  and  THEOPHORI, 
(XpioTOipopoi  KOI  Bcocfiopoi.,  Christ-hearers 
and  God-hearers,)  names  given  to  Christians 
in  the  earliest  times,  on  account  of  the  com- 
munion between  Christ,  who  is  God,  and  the 
Church.  Ignatius  commences  his  Epistles 
thus,  'lyvdrws  6  koI  &€o^6pos :  and  it  is 
related  in  the  acts  of  his  martyrdom,  that 
hearing  him  called  Theophorus,  Trajan 
asked  the  meaning  of  the  name ;  to  which 
Ignatius  replied,  it  meant  one  that  carries 
Christ  in  his  heart.  "  Dost  thou  then,"  said 
Trajan,  "  carry  him  that  was  crucified  in 
thy  heart  ?  "  "  Yes,"  said  tlie  holy  martyr, 
"  for  it  is  written,  I  will  dwell  in  them,;  and 
walk  in  them." — Bingham,  i.  1,  4. 

CHRONICLES.  Two  canonical  books 
of  the  Old  Testament.  They  contain  the 
history  of  about  3500  years,  from  the  cre- 
ation until  after  the  return  of  the  Jews 
from  Babylon.  They  are  fuller  and  more 
comprehensive  than  the  Books  of  Kings. 
The  Greek  interpreters  hence  call  them 
HapaXeiTTopiva,  supplements,  additions.  The 
Jews  make  but  one  book  of  the  Chronicles, 


CHURCH  ARCHITECTURE 

under  the  title  Dihree  luijamin,  i.e.  journal 
or  annals.  Ezra  is  generally  supposed  to 
be  the  author  of  these  books.  The  Chroni- 
cles, or  Paraleipomena,  are  an  abridgment, 
in  fact,  of  the  whole  Scripture  history  of  the 
Old  Testament.  St.  Jerome  so  calls  it, "  Om- 
nis  traditio  Scripturarum  in  hoc  cmitinetur." 
The  First  Book  contains  a  genealogical 
account  of  the  descent  of  Israel  from  Adam, 
and  of  the  reign  of  David.  The  Second 
Book  contains  the  history  of  Judah  to  the 
very  year  of  the  Jews'  return  from  the 
Babylonish  captivity — the  decree  of  Cyrus 
granting  them  liberty  being  in  the  last 
chapter  of  this  Second  Book. 

CHURCH  ARCHITECTURE.  This 
subject  is  much  too  large  to  treat  of  here 
except  very  generally,  and  especially  all 
beyond  the  Gothic  styles,  to  which  nearly 
all  church  architecture  out  of  Italy  and 
Spain  belongs.  That  which  is  called  Italian 
Gothic — an  entirely  different  thing  from 
that  called  the  Italian  or  classical  style — 
was  hastily  taken  up  by  architects  at  the 
instigation  of  Mr.  Euskin  and  because  they 
wanted  something  new,  and  has  already 
subsided  again,  after  producing  not  one  good 
English  specimen,  and  a  multitude  of  very 
ugly  ones.  It  is  very  inferior  to  the  real 
Gothic,  which  reached  its  highest  perfection 
in  this  country  and  most  others  in  the 
fourteenth  century ;  which  period  was 
occupied  here  by  the  early  or  Geometrical, 
and  by  the  later  or  Flowing  Decorated 
styles,  while  the  Early  English  or  lancet 
window  style  occupied  the  thirteenth, 
speaking  roundly,  and  the  Norman  the 
twelfth.  The  Perpendicular  succeeded  the 
Decorated  and  lasted  quite  through  the 
fifteenth  century  and  somewhat  more,  till 
it  sank  into  the  Tudor  :  by  which  time  new 
churches  almost  ceased  to  be  built,  and 
many  old  ones  were  destroyed  with  the 
monasteries  to  which  they  belonged.  Since 
then  all  the  architecture  of  Europe  has  been 
only  copied  or  compounded  from  some 
older  styles;  and  probably  always  will  be 
for  the  future.  All  attempts  at  new  ones 
have  been  miserable  failures. 

The  chief  differences  between  the  great 
foreign  churches  and  the  British  are,  that 
we  cultivated  length  and  the  continentals 
height,  and  they  decidedly  beat  us  in  the 
magnificence  of  their  porches.  Many  of 
their  cathedrals  too  have  double  aisles,  and 
very  few  of  ours.  But  our  proportions  are 
on  the  whole  much  better  than  theirs  ; 
and  so  are  our  steeples  of  all  kinds.  There 
is  nothing  abroad  comparable  to  those  of 
Lincoln  and  Salisbury  and  some  others. 
Excessive  height  of  body  dwarfs  and 
spoils  every  other  dimension,  but  length 
does  not.  That  may  be  seen  at  West- 
minster, which  looks  too  narrow,  though  it 


CHUEUH  AECHITECTURE 

is  among  our  widest  naves ;  while  the  great 
visible  length  of  Ely  or  Canterbiiry  and  of 
the  naves  of  St.  Alb.an's,  Winchester,  Nor- 
wich or  Peterboroxigh,  does  not  at  all 
detract  from  their  other  dimensions,  but 
increases  the  grandeur  of  the  whole.  The 
great  height  and  double  aisles  of  the  foreign 
cathedrals,  with  the  necessary  multitude  of 
flying  buttresses,  also  confuse  their  outline, 
Isesides  making  them  look  short.  Mr.  Fer- 
gusson  truly  says  that  the  very  high 
foreign  naves  give  an  uncomfortable  im- 
pression of  effort,  if  not  of  insecurity,  very 
inferior  to  the  repose  which  is  the  charac- 
teristic of  our  cathedrals  with  their  beauti- 
ful proportions,  varied  as  they  are,  but 
observing  one  almost  constant  rule,  that  the 
whole  internal  width  is  equal  to  the  internal 
height,  which  Westminster  alone  much 
transgresses,  being  only  75  feet  wide  and 
103  high. 

The  great  useless  hall  of  the  new  Law 
Courts,  to  which  the  general  construction 
was  sacrificed  and  enormous  expense  wasted 
on  it,  is  just  wider  than  the  middle  or 
nave  proper  of  our  largest  cathedrals,  and 
of  about  their  height,  and  yet  looks  so 
narrow  that  it  has  been  likened  to  "  a  covered 
ditch."  The  architect  forgot  that  in  all 
the  cathedrals  the  eye  wanders  through 
pUlars  into  aisles,  and  even  in  King's 
chapel  (which  most  resembles  it,  and  is 
longer  still,  and  yet  does  not  look  narrow) 
into  side  chapels  through  windows  all  along, 
while  the  other  is  confined  by  bare  walls. 
Westminster  Hall  is  about  half  as  wide 
again,  and  not  too  high,  and  the  many 
doors  along  one  side  of  it  take  away  any 
idea  of  confinement,  besides  the  sort  of 
transept  which  Barry  dexterously  added  at 
the  end,  giving  the  effect  of  an  unlimited 
opening  sideways.  Continuing  the  remarks 
on  the  dimensions  of  cathedrals  from  what 
was  said  under  that  head,  and  on  the 
sometimes  disputed  question  of  length,  it 
seems  that  Winchester  is  the  longest  of  all 
Gothic  cathedrals  by  a  very  few  feet  over 
St.  Alban's.  They  are  both  practically  a 
tenth  of  a  mile  lono;  inside.  But  the  nave 
of  St.  Alban's  is  the  longest  by  a  whole 
bay  or  severy,  and  almost  exactly  the  same 
as  King's  Chapel,  289  feet.  Neverthe- 
less York,  Lincoln,  Ely  and  Canterbury  all 
look  longer,  and  particularly  Ely  from  its 
shape  and  position,  because  their  high  roofs 
go  from  one  end  to  the  other,  while  at  the 
two  longest,  and  at  sundry  others,  the  Lady 
chapels  at  the  east  end  drop  and  are  not 
seen  from  a  distance.  The  two  highest 
towers  are  at  Lincoln  and  Boston,  both 
266  feet.  The  spire  of  Salisbury  is  much 
the  finest  in  the  world,  though  not  the 
highest,  404  feet.  The  cross  of  St.  Paul's 
is  only  375,  though  it  used  to  be  called  as 


CHURCH  ARCHITECTURE        165 

high  as  Salisbury.  The  oldest  cathedral  in 
any  considerable  part  now  remaining  is 
probably  St.  Alban's,  though  there  are  some 
older  churches.  And  it  is  remarkable  that 
the  whole  of  its  inside  is  plastered,  except  a 
few  pieces  of  arcades  and  pillars  subsequent 
to  the  square  Norman  ones. 

The  general  arrangement  of  English 
cathedrals  has  been  described  already.  The 
monastic  and  collegiate  churches  of  con- 
siderable size  generally  followed  much  the 
same  plan  of  the  Latin  cross,  with  aisles 
and  other  appendages  according  to  the  size 
that  was  wanted.  Perhaps  also  some  that 
were  only  intended  for  parish  churches  were 
on  the  same  plan;  but  undoubtedly  some 
very  large  ones  of  early  dates  were  not,  but 
consisted  only  of  a  nave  with  aisles  and  a 
chancel  with  or  without  them,  and  a  steeple 
at  the  west  end.  Boston  and  Grantham  at 
once  occur  as  examples  of  that  kind.  Boston 
tower  is  practically  of  the  same  height  as 
Lincoln,  and  Grantham  is  the  next  spire  to 
Salisbury  in  size  and  architecture  together, 
and  of  the  same  style,  though  Norwich  and 
a  few  others  are  higher.  There  is  no  doubt 
that  churches  of  that  type  are  better  for 
work  than  those  of  the  cathedral  tjrpe, 
though  not  nearly  so  handsome.  After 
these  come  what  may  be  called  the  college 
chapel  type,  which  architecturally  consist 
of  a  chancel  only ;  or  at  any  rate  the 
chancel  is  the  part  used  by  the  congregation, 
though  there  may  be  an  ante-chapel  besides, 
like  those  of  Merton,  New  College,  Mag- 
dalene (Ox.),  and  the  modem  St.  John's  of 
Cambridge,  which  would  have  been  much 
better  without  all  its  western  part,  both 
tower  and  transepts  being  iU-proportioned 
and  clumsy,  which  the  chancel,  a  real 
chapel,  is  not.  King's  chapel  is  uniform 
throughout  its  whole  length  of  289  feet,  and 
only  divided  internally  by  the  wooden 
screen ;  and  so  is  that  of  Trinity,  of  which 
the  screen  was  moved  quite  lately  farther 
west.  Even  the  four  round  churches  of 
the  Temple,  Cambridge,  Northampton  and 
Little  Maplestead,  are  of  that  order,  the 
square  chancels  being  the  working  part, 
and  the  "  rounds "  fSrming  only  a  west 
tower  and  ante-chapel.  The  working  nave 
of  St.  Alban's,  which  is  practically^  the 
parish  church,  divided  from  the  choir  by  a 
stone  screen  with  only  two  small  doors, 
makes  a  church  of  the  college  chapel  kind, 
and  is  of  just  the  same  length  as  the  whole  of 
Bath  Abbey  ;  for  three  of  the  architectural 
nave  bays  belong  to  the  working  choir,  as 
at  Westminster.  It  is  unnecessary  to 
pursue  these  details  farther. 

In  a  few  large  churches  the  vestry  is  a 
low  building  at  the  east  end,  like  a  Lady 
chapel ;  and  occasionally  there  was  a  room 
over  the  south  porch  called  a  parvise,  for  a 


166       CHURCH  ARCHITECTURE 

clergyman  to  live  iu.  The  south  door  of  the 
chancel  is  generally  called  the  priest's  door. 
The  font  is  usually  near  the  west  end, 
either  in  the  tower  or  the  S.W.  corner 
of  the  nave,  unless  there  is  a  separate 
baptistery;  the  pulpit  is  generally  at  the 
N.E.  corner  of  the  nave  in  large  churches, 
but  often  S.E.  in  small  ones ;  and  in  some 
cathedral  naves ;  though  the  choir  pulpit  is 
always  on  the  north  in  cathedrals,  facing 
the  bishop's  throne  on  the  south.  Some  of 
the  modem  nave  pulpits  in  cathedrals  are 
against  the  S.E.  great  pier  of  the  tower. 
In  all  these  matters  there  is  no  law  but 
convenience.  When  there  is  a  litany  desk, 
it  is  generally  at  the  east  end  of  the  nave. 

The  82nd  canon  requires  a  convenient 
seat  to  read  the  prayers  from.  It  is  gene- 
rally placed  at  the  west  of  the  choir  seats ; 
and  it  is  very  convenient,  and  now  usual, 
to  have  two  such  reading  desks  for  the 
clergy  who  take  different  parts  of  the 
service,  besides  a  lectern  for  the  Bible ; 
which  always  faces  the  people  if  there  is 
one,  and  in  a  long  church  should  have  two 
or  three  steps.  The  kneeling  stools  for 
pulpits,  and  still  more  for  reading  desks, 
require  more  attention  than  they  generally 
receive.  They  should  always  be  open  un- 
derneath, not  closed  boxes  or  hassocks,  to 
leave  room  for  the  reader's  feet,  and  also 
to  enable  him  to  pull  the  stool  forward  by 
his  own  foot.  Another  way  is  to  make  the 
top  turn  on  a  hinge,  nearly  balanced,  so 
that  you  can  tip  them  up  out  of  the  way 
when  you  have  to  stand,  and  bring  them 
down  again  quietly  for  kneeling.  The 
inner  edge  of  the  book  desk  for  men  of 
moderate  height  should  be  three  feet  from 
the  floor ;  and  the  desk  itself  at  least  six- 
teen inches  wide,  and  more  for  a  folio  book. 
It  is  a  very  good  plan  to  put  the  slip 
or  fillet  five  or  six  inches  up  the  desk  for 
the  prayer  book  to  rest  on  while  you  are 
kneeling,  as  it  keeps  your  arms  off  the 
book,  and  leaves  room  for  hymn-books 
below,  without  continual  shifting.  No  one 
need  expect  architects  to  attend  to  such 
details.  The  desk  round  the  top  of  a 
pulpit  ought  also  to  be  wide,  and  rather 
sloping.  If  it  is  about  three  and  a  half  feet 
above  the  floor,  an  ordinary  man  not  short- 
sighted will  not  require  a  separate  little 
sermon-desk. 

In  some  old  churches  there  remains  a 
small  bell-cot  over  the  east  wall  of  the 
nave,  like  that  which  is  often  built  for  a 
single  bell,  or  for  two,  at  the  west  in  small 
churches  with  no  tower.  That  was  called 
the  sancfus  bell,  and  was  rung  at  the  "  eleva- 
tion of  the  host,"  and  at  the  words  "  Sanctus, 
sanctus,  Deus  sabaoth,"  to  inform  the  people 
outside.  The  bell  gable  in  small  churches 
is  sometimes  built  over  the  arch  dividing 


CHURCH,  EARLY  BRITISH 

the  chancel  from  the  nave  and  in  that 
case  they  ought  to  be  of  the  same  height, 
and  always  were  in  old  times ;  and  so  the 
roofs  all  round  a  central  tower  were  always 
of  the  same  height,  except  occasionally 
when  they  were  of  different,  dates  and  not 
parts  of  one  plan.    [G-.] 

CHURCH,  THE  EARLY  BRITISH. 
Materials  for  the  history  of  its  origin  are 
exceedingly  meagre.  Any  national  con- 
temporary records  which  may  have  existed 
during  the  first  five  centuries  have  perished. 
This  was  the  complaint  of  Gildas  (HisL 
§  4,  p.  13),  writing  in  the  sixth  century. 
Our  knowledge  of  the  subject,  such  as  it  is, 
comes  from  a  few  passages  scattered  through 
the  pages  of  foreign  historians;  but  con- 
jecture of  course  has  been  busy,  and  the 
legendary  matter  is  very  copious,  in  propor- 
tion to  the  scantiness  of  trustworthy  in- 
formation. 

The  notion  that  the  British  Church  was 
of  apostolic  origin  rested  almost  entirely 
upon  one  sentence  in  the  writings  of  St. 
Clement,  Bishop  of  Rome  a.d.  95  (JEp.  ad 
Cor.  5),  where  he  says  that  St.  Paul  came 
"  to  the  boundary  of  the  West  (eVl  to  rip^a. 
Tijr  hva^ais  ekBav),  an  expression  which 
may  probably  denote  a  visit  to  Spain, 
possibly  one  extended  to'  Gaul;  but  not 
beyond.  Nor  is  there  any  positive  evidence 
that  Christianity  was  introduced  into  Britain 
in  the  second  century,  although  there  is  a. 
presumption  in  favour  of  the  supposition. 
The  story  told  by  Bede  (ff.  E.  i.  4,  v.  24), 
that  Lucius,  a  British  king,  wTOte  a  letter 
to  Pope  Eleutherus  requesting  instruction 
from  him  in  Christianity,  and  that  he- 
obtained  the  fulfilment  of  his  pious  wish, 
may  be  a  mere  fable,  as  the  date  of 
Eleutherus  was  about  a.d.  177,  and  the 
statement  in  Bede  is  derived  from  a  Rornan 
catalogue  of  the  Popes  framed  in  a.d.  530. 
Moreover,  Nennius  (c.  xviii.),  writing  in  the 
ninth  century,  ascribes  the  conversion  of 
Lucius  to  Pope  Evaristus,  a.d.  100-109, 
and  magnifies  the  story  into  the  conversion 
of  all  Britain.  Some  support,  however,  for 
the  narrative  may  perhaps  be  found  in  th& 
statement  of  TertuUian  (^Adv.  Jud.  vii.) 
about  A.D.  200,  that  "places  in  Britain 
hitherto  unvisited  by  the  Romans  were 
subjected  to  Christianity." 

Origen,  ivriting  early  in  the  third  century, 
(nom.  vi.  ill  Luc.  i.  24,)  speaks  of  Britain 
as  converted  to  the  Christian  faith,  and 
more  rhetorically  in  Homil.  iv.  in  Ezek., 
but  on  the  other  hand,  in  Homil.  xxviii.  in 
St.  Matt,  xxiv.,  he  mentions  the  Britons 
amongst  a  number  of  barbarous  nations  of 
whom  the  greater  part  (plurimi)  "  had  not 
yet  heard  the  word  of  the  Gospel." 

Eusebius,  also,  in  one  rhetorical  passage, 
Dem.  Ev.  iii.   5,   c.   a.d.  315,  w-rites  as  if 


CHURCH,  EAELY  BRITISH 

some  of  the  twelve  or  of  the  seventy  had 
crossed  the  ocean  "  to  the  isles  called 
British,"  but  in  his  History,  iii.  1,  where  he 
describes  the  mission-fields  of  the  Apostles 
on  the  authority  of  Origen,  he  makes  no 
mention  of  Britain. 

On  the  whole,  we  may  safely  infer  from 
these  scattered  notices,  combined  with  the 
statements  of  later  writers  in  the  fourth 
century,  such  as  St.  Athanasius,  St.  Jerome, 
and  St.  Chrysostom,  which  seem  to  imply 
the  existence  of  a  Church  long  settled  in 
Britain,  that  Christianity  was  introduced 
in  the  second  or  early  in  the  third  century : 
probably  by  missionaries  from  Gaul,  al- 
though Graul  itself,  according  to  Greg. 
Tur.  Hist.  i.  28,  was  not  completely  con- 
verted before  the  third  century.  The  new 
religion  probably  took  most  hold  of  the 
Roman  residents  or  Romanized  natives,  and 
did  not  strike  its  roots  very  widely  or 
deeply.  The  story  of  the  persecution  of 
Christians  in  Britain  at  the  end  of  the  third 
century  (Sax.  Chron.),  or  beginning  of  the 
fourth  (Bede,  H.  X  i.  7 ;  Gildas,  Hist,  viii.), 
and  of  the  martyrdom  of  St.  Alban  (perhaps 
also  of  Aaron  and  Julius),  cannot  safely  be 
rejected,  although  naturally  mixed  up  with 
a  large  quantity  of  legendary  matter. 

Three  British  bishops  were  present  at  the 
Council  of  Aries  summoned  by  Constantine 
in  A.D.  314  to  settle  the  difficulties  which 
arose  out  of  the  Donatist  schism  (Labb.  i. 
1430 ;  Mansi,  u.  466,  467). 

There  is  no  evidence  for  or  against  the 
presence  of  British  bishops  at  the  Council 
of  Niwea,  a.d.  325,  but  the  British  Church 
generally  assented  to  the  decrees  of  that 
council  respecting  Arianism  and  the  time  of 
keeping  Easter  (Athanas.  ad  Gov.  Imper., 
and  Constant.  Epist.  ad  Ecdes.  ap.  Euseb. 
Vit.  Const,  iii.,  xvii.).  The  British  Church 
also  assented  to  the  resolution  of  the  Coun- 
cil of  Sardica,  a.d.  347,  directed  against 
those  who  maligned  Athanasius  (Athan. 
Apol.  Cnnt.  Arian.  and  Hist,  Arian.  ad 
Monach.).  British  bishops  were  present  at 
the  Council  of  Ariminum  (Rimini)  a.d.  359, 
which  was  entrapped  into  surrendering  the 
terms  ovcria  and  ofioovcrios ;  and  Sulpicius 
Severus  relates  {Hist.  Sac.  ii.  41),  that  three 
of  them  were  so  poor  that  their  expenses 
were  paid  out  of  the  imperial  treasury. 

The  general  orthodoxy  however  of  the 
British  Church  in  the  fourth  century  is 
abundantly  testified  by  Athanasius  himself 
(loc.  cit.  supra),  by  St.  Chrysostom,  e.g. 
Serm.  de  Util.  Sect.  Script,  and  Contra 
Judseos,  and  by  Jerome  repeatedly  (see 
especially  Ep.  101,  ad  Evangel.). 

In  the  fifth  century  the  tranquillity  of 
the  British  Church  was  disturbed,  and  its 
reputation  somewhat  tarnished,  by  the 
heresy  of  Pelagius.     He   was  a  native  of 


CHURCH,  EARLY  BRITISH         167 

Britain,  and  although  ho  does  not  seem  to 
have  resided  there,  his  doctrines  were  pro- 
pagated in  the  island  with  some  success  by 
Agricola,  son  of  a  bishop  Severianus,  who 
had  adopted  the  notions  of  Pelagius  (Prosp. 
Aquitan.  Chron.}.  The  British  clergy  ap- 
pealed to  the  Church  in  Gaul  for  help  in 
contending  with  this  pernicious  teaching, 
and  a  large  synod  of  the  Galilean  Church,  a  .d. 
429,  elected 'Germanus,  bishop  of  Auxerre, 
and  Lupus,  bishop  of  Troyes,  as  mis.'iionary 
envoys  to  bring  back  the  erring  British  to 
the  right  faith.  The  election  had  either 
been  recommended  or  was  afterwards 
approved  by  Pope  Celestine  (Comp.  Prosp. 
Aquit.  and  Constant,  de  Vila  Oerman.  i. 
19,  23;  Bede,  i.  17).  The  Gallican 
deputies  were  diligent  in  preaching  not 
only  in  churches,  but  in  the  open  air ;  the 
people  generally  were  reclaimed  to  the 
Catholic  faith,  and  the  Pelagianists,  who 
ventured  after  some  deliberation  to  challenge 
their  antagonists  to  a  public  debate,  were 
ignominiously  refuted  at  Verulam.  The 
triumph  of  the  orthodox  party  was  clenched 
by  some  miracles  supposed  to  be  wrought  by 
the  prelates,  especially  at  the  tomb  of  St. 
Alban,  and  still  more  by  a  great  victory 
gained  by  the  Britons  over  the  Picts  and 
Saxons  on  the  borders  of  North  Wales  under 
the  direction  of  Germanus  and  Lupus,  who 
had  baptized  a  large  number  of  the  comba- 
tants on  Easter-eve  just  before  the  battle. 
The  host  rushed  upon  their  foes  with  loud 
shouts  of  Alleluia,  and  completely  routed 
them,  whence  the  fight  was  called  the 
Alleluia  victory.  (Bede,  i.  20;  Constant, 
Vita.  Germ.  i.  19,  23,  25.)  The  Gallican 
bishops  then  left  Britain,  but  Germanus 
paid  a  second  visit  in  447,  accompanied  by 
a  disciple  of  Lupus,  Severus,  bishop  of 
Trier  (Treves).  Some  people  who  had 
relapsed  into  heresy  were  reclaimed,  and 
some  false  teachers  expelled.  Germanus 
died  in  the  following  year,  and  his  name 
was  held  in  great  honour  in  the  British 
Church  in  the  regions  of  Wales  and  Corn- 
wall. 

The  death  of  Germanus  nearly  coincides 
with  the  beginning  of  the  period  of  Saxon 
conquest,  which,  roughly  speaking,  extended 
from  the  year  A.D.  450  to  680;  and  the 
history  of  the  British  Church  between  these 
dates  may  be  summed  up  in  a  few  words. 
If  there  is  any  truth  at  all  in  the  declama- 
tions of  Gildas,  the  moral  condition  of  the 
British,  including  the  clergy,  at  the  time 
when  the  Saxon  invasion  began,  was  deplor- 
ably corrupt.  The  great  majority  of  the 
people  were  gradually  forced  westwards  by 
the  invaders,  and  the  few  who  remained 
either  as  slaves  or  in  a  half-servile  condition 
amongst  their  conquerors  were  unable  or 
unwilling  to  convert  them  to  the  faith  of 


168       CHUEOH,  EARLY  BRITISH 

Christ.  Wales  was  the  principal  stronghold 
of  the  national  life,  both  political  and 
religious.  Several  large  colleges  or  monas- 
teries, called  Bangor,  which  signifies  "  high 
circle,"  i.e.  "distinguished  community," 
were  the  principal  centres  of  religious 
knowledge  and  activity.  A  large  number 
of  monks  were  slaughtered  at  Bangor  Yscoed, 
near  Chester,  in  613,  by  the  Anglian  invader 
.^thelfrith,  king  of  Northumbria.  Between 
the  dates  550  and  570  a  mission  was  sent 
to  Ireland  from  Wales  under  the  auspices  of 
St.  David,  St.  Gildas,  and  St.  Cadoc,  to 
restore  the  Christian  faith,  which  was  said  to 
be  decadent  there.  Two  synods  were  held 
in  Wales  about  the  year  569,  one  at  Lland- 
dewi  Brefi,  near  the  site  of  the  Roman  Loven- 
tium,  the  other  at  a  place  called  Lucus 
Viotorise,  the  Wood  of  Victory,  of  which  the 
site  caimot  be  identified,  but  it  was  pro- 
bably near  Llanddewi  Brefi.  All  records, 
however,  of  the  purposes  for  which  these 
synods  were  convened,  and  of  the  transactions 
which  took  place  at  them,  have  been  lost. 
The  lives  of  the  Cornish  and  Welsh  saints 
have  been  overlaid  with  such  a  mass  of 
legend,  that  it  is  almost  impossible  to 
recover  their  real  history.  All  that  can  be 
safely  afiirmed  respecting  the  celebrated 
St.  David  is  that  he  attended,  probably 
presided  at,  the  councils  just  mentioned, 
that  he  founded  the  see  at  Menevia,  which 
was  called  after  his  name  (see  St.  David), 
and  died  about  the  year  600. 

Dubrioius  was  the  first  bishop  of  LlandalF, 
and  died,  after  resigning  his  see,  at  Bardsey, 
in  612.  The  story  of  an  archbishopric  held 
first  by  him  at  Caerleon,  and  afterwards 
transferred  by  St.  David  to  Menevia,  is 
totally  without  foundation ;  nor  is  there  any 
trustworthy  evidence  of  any  archbishopric 
in  Britain  prior  to  the  coming  of  St.  Augus- 
tine. (See  Archbishop.)  The  three  British 
bishops  who  were  present  at  the  Council  of 
Aries,  Restitutus  of  London,  Eborius  of 
York,  and  Adelphius  (conjecturaliy)  of 
Caerleon,  were  probably  selected  as  the  most 
eminent  representatives  who  could  be  sent, 
■  but  they  are  not  called  archbishops.  The 
Welsh  sees  were,  (I)  Bangor,  (2)  Llanwelly 
or  St.  Asaph,  (3)  St.  David's,  (4)  Llanda- 
ham  (in  Cardigan),  (5)  Llandaff. 

Two  British  bishops,  probably  from  Devon 
or  Cornwall,  are  mentioned  by  Bede,  S.  E. 
iii.  28,  as  taking  part  with  Wini,  bishop  of 
Winchester,  in  the  consecration  of  Ceadda 
to  the  see  of  York,  in  664.  St.  Germans 
and  Bodmin  dispute  the  claim  to  be  the 
original  see  of  Cornwall,  and  the  question 
cannot  certainly  be  determined.  In  North 
Britain  (Strathclyde  and  Cumbria),  the 
bishopric  of  Candida  Casa,  i.e.  Whitehom, 
was  founded  by  St.  Ninian  early  in  the  fifth 
century,  and  that  of  Glasgow  by  Kentigern 


CHDECH,  EARLY  BRITISH 

about  the  middle  or  latter  part  of  the  sixth. 
(See  Church  in  Scotland.)  The  monastery 
of  Hy  or  Icolmkill  (lona)  was  founded  in 
563  by  the  celebrated  Irish  missionary  St. 
Columba,  who  died  soon  after  the  landing 
of  St.  Augustine  in  Kent. 

It  v.'ill  be  apparent  from  the  foregoing 
sketch  that  there  was  no  direct  continuity 
between  the  early  British  Church  and  the 
Church  of  England  founded  by  Augustine 
at  the  close  of  the  sixth  century.  The 
conversion  of  England,  indeed,  especially  of 
the  northern  parts,  was  largely  due,  after 
the  arrival  of  Augustine,  to  Celtic  mission- 
aries, but  generally  of  Scottish,  i.e.  Irish, 
origin  or  training,  and  in  no  way  to  be 
regarded  as  emissaries  or  representatives  of 
the  British  Ciiurch.  The  British  clergy  as 
a  body  shared  in  the  national  antipathy 
to  the  Saxon  invader,  and  looked  with 
suspicion  and  jealousy  upon  Augustine  and 
his  companions  as  foreigners  who  had  in 
some  measure  allied  themselves  with  the 
conquerors  of  Britain.  Augustine's  want  of 
tact  and  conciliatory  demeanour  at  the 
synod  of  Augustine's  Oak  (Bede,  ii.  2) 
repelled  them  still  further,  and  rendered 
any  cordial  union  or  co-operation  impossible. 
And  besides  these  obstacles  to  fusion,  which 
were  inherent  in  the  character  and  circum- 
stances of  the  two  parties,  there  were  some 
diflerences  in  discipline  and  ritual,  which 
were  the  outward  and  formal  hindrances  to 
it.  (i.)  The  British  Church  regulated  the 
time  of  keeping  Easter  by  the  cycle  which 
the  Roman  Church  had  used  up  to  the  year 
458,  but  had  subsequently  changed,  and 
counted  as  Eastei  -day  the  Sunday  which 
fell  next  after  the  Equinox  between  the 
fourteenth  and  twentieth  day  of  the  moon,  not 
as  it  had  come  to  be  at  Rome,  between  the 
fifteenth  and  twenty-first  (Bede,  iii.  17,  and 
ii.  2).  (See  Easter.)  (ii).  There  was  some 
difierence  between  the  Roman  and  the 
British  mode  of  administering  baptism 
(Bede,  ii.  2),  though  what  it  was  is  not 
definitely  stated,  (iii.)  The  British  mode 
of  tonsure  difiered  both  from  the  Roman 
and  the  Greek  (Bede,  iv.  1;  v.  21).  The 
British  had  also  some  rites  and  ceremonies 
peculiar  to  themselves  in  the  mode  of  cele- 
brating mass,  of  ordaining  the  clergy  and 
consecrating  bishops. 

All  these  divergences  from  the  practice  of 
the  Roman  Church,  although  many  of  them 
were  insignificant  in  themselves,  helped  to 
make  the  Italian  missionaries,  and  those 
who  followed  their  teachiog,  look  down  upon 
the  British  Chiu:ch  as  barbarous,  and  behind 
the  age,  if  not  positively  heretical,  while  the 
British  on  their  side  clung  for  the  most  part 
to  their  ancient  usages  with  the  tenacity 
natural  iu  a  proud,  insulated  people  smarting 
under  the  wrongs  of   foreign   conquest. — 


CHUECH  OF  ENGLAND 

Eaddan  and  Stubbs'  Councils,  vol.  i. ;  Bright, 
Early  English  Ch.  Bist.  chap.  i. ;  Lingard, 
History  of  Anglo-Saxon  Church,  chap.  i. 
[W.  B.  W.  S.] 

CHURCH  OP  ENGLAND.  By  the 
Church  of  England  we  mean  that  branch  of 
the  Catholic  Church  which  is  established 
under  canonical  bishops  in  England. 

L  Its  origin  dates  from  the  mission  of 
Augustine  sent  by  Pope  Gregory  the  Great, 
with  a  band  of  about  40  monks  in  the  year 
A.D.  597.  British  Christianity  had  been 
forced  back  with  the  Britons  by  their 
Teutonic  invaders  into  the  remote  western 
parts  of  the  island.  It  does  not  seem  to 
have  retained  a  very  strong  hold  upon  the 
Britons  themselves;  stiU  less  had  it  exer- 
cised any  appreciable  influence  upon  the 
minds  of  their  conquerors.  And  since 
Augustine  and  his  followers  did  not  enter 
into  any  alliance  with  the  Britons  for  the 
conversion  of  the  English,  it  cannot  be 
truly  said  that  there  was  any  continuity  of 
life  between  the  old  British  and  the  English 
Church.     (See  Church,  the  Early  British.) 

After  converting  ^thelberht,  king  of 
Kent,  and  his  people,  Augustine  crossed 
over  to  Gaul,  and  having  been  consecrated 
by  Vergilius,  bishop  of  Aries,  returned  to 
England  and  became  the  first  archbishop 
of  Canterbury,  the  Metropolitan  See.  The 
Sees  of  Rochester  and  London  were  founded 
soon  afterwards  (in  a.d.  604),  and  the  See 
of  York,  although  not  made  Metropolitan 
till  many  years  later,  was  founded  in  625, 
and  these  were  the  only  Sees  directly  due  to 
the  mission  of  Augustine.  The  conversion 
of  the  rest  of  the  country  was  a  very 
gradual  process,  covering  nearly  a  century, 
and  not  conducted  on  any  fixed  plan,  or 
resulting  from  the  combined  efforts  of  a 
large  body  of  missionaries,  but  due  rather 
to  the  zeal  and  enterprise  of  individuals  of 
different  nationalities  labouring  indepen- 
dently in  the  several  kingdoms.  Thus 
Wessex  was  converted  by  Birinus,  a 
missionary  from  North  Italy ;  East  Anglia 
by  FeHx,  a  Burgundian ;  Northumbria  and 
Mercia  mainly  by  Celtic  teachers;  Essex 
by  Cedd,  a  Northumbrian,  but  trained  in  the 
Scottish  school ;  and  last  of  all  (about  680) 
Sussex  by  Wilfrith,  a  native  of  Northumbria, 
but  an  adherent  of  the  Roman  school. 
The  dioceses  were  as  a  rule  originally 
conterminous  with  the  kingdoms  in  which 
they  were  founded,  but  as  the  kingdoms 
were  enlarged  the  dioceses  were  subdivided ; 
generally,  however,  in  accordance  with  the 
lines  of  some  tribal  settlement.  The  first 
home  of  the  bishop  was  generally  near 
some  royal  dwelling ;  here  was  his  church 
containing  his  chair  (cathedra),  throne  or 
"  stool,"  as  it  was  called  in  old  English ; 
and  here  was  the  centre  of  missionary  work 


CHURCH  OF  ENGLAND 


169 


from  which  the  monks  and  priests  who 
lived  with  the  bishop  (generally  under 
some  kind  of  monastic  rule)  went  forth  to 
convert  the  surrounding  country,  and  to 
which  they  returned  to  recruit  their  strength 
and  prepare  themselves  by  study  and  prayer 
for  further  labours.  They  preached  and 
baptized  at  the  foot  of  the  crosses  which 
were  set  up  in  villages,  or  on  the  estates  of 
nobles  until  parishes  were  formed,  parish 
churches  erected,  and  permanent  clergy 
attached  to  them.  The  endowments  of  the 
churches,  whether  cathedral,  monastic,  or 
parochial,  and  the  emoluments  of  the  clergy 
were  derived  from  various  sources,  lands, 
tithes,  free  offerings,  and  fees  of  several 
kinds,  but  they  were  aU  due  to  the  piety 
and  liberality  of  individual  benefactors,  not 
to  any  formal  enactments  of  the  state. 

Prior  to  the  Norman  Conquest  there  was 
the  closest  connexion  between  the  Church 
and  the  State,  first  in  the  several  kingdoms, 
and  afterwards  in  the  whole  nation  when 
the  kingdom  of  Wessex  had  absorbed  all 
the  others.  The  ecclesiastical  councils  are 
sometimes  scarcely  distinguishable  from  the 
Witanagemotes ;  they  were  frequently  at- 
tended by  the  kings  and  ealdormen,  and  on 
the  other  hand  the  bishops  sat  in  the 
Witanagemotes,  and  presided  co-ordinately 
with  laymen  in  the  hundred-moot  and 
shire-moot.  The  unity  of  faith,  of  cere- 
monial, and  of  discipline  which  was  due  in  a 
great  measure  to  the  organisation  by  Arch- 
bishop Theodore  in  the  seventh  centm-y, 
helped  more  than  any  other  influence  to 
consolidate  the  nation  by  creating  a  tie  of 
sympathy  between  the  tribal  divisions.  In 
their  lay  aspect  men  might  be  Mercians  or 
West  Saxons,  Englishmen  or  Danes,  but  as 
members  of  the  same  Church  they  realized 
that  they  were  fellow-countrymen.  Thus 
it  would  be  more  true  to  say  that  the 
Church  established  the  nation  than  that  the 
nation  established  the  Church. 

n.  The  effects  of  the  Norman  Conquest 
upon  the  Church  were  manifold,  but  may 
be  summed  up  under  a  few  main  heads. 

(i.)  The  invasion  of  England  by  William, 
having  l)een  expressly  sanctioned  by  the 
pope,  brought  the  Church  into  immediate 
and  direct  connexion  with  the  Papal  See, 
which  had  hitherto  exercised  only  a  vague 
and  precarious  influence  over  it;  and  so 
paved  the  way  for  many  encroachments  of 
the  Papacy  on  the  national  rights  and 
liberties  of  the  Church,  (ii.)  the  separation 
made  by  the  Conqueror  between  the 
ecclesiastical  and  secular  courts,  and  the 
trial  of  ecclesiastical  causes  by  canonical  law 
instead  of  customary  law,  just  when  the 
canon  law  was  growing  into  a  vast  system 
of  jurisprudence,  gave  the  clergy  a  position 
of  remarkable  importance  and  iudependence, 


170 


CHURCH  OF  ENGLAND 


strengthened  the  coiniexiun  with  Rome,  to 
which  appeals  now  became  customary,  and 
laid  the  foundation  of  much  future  strife 
between  the  Church  and  the  Crown,  (iii.) 
the  appointment  of  foreigners  to  bishoprics, 
often  royal  chaplains,  men  of  secular  ha- 
bits, employed  on  much  secular  business, 
possessing  manors  and  castles  like  other 
barons  of  the  realm,  and  often  living  more 
like  lay  barons  than  bishops,  weakened 
the  tie  between  the  bishop  and  his 
clergy,  and  especially  at  the  cathedral 
church  of  which  he  became  rather  the 
absent  lord  and  visitor  than  the  resident 
head,  (iv.)  a  great  developement  of  mo- 
nasticism,  leading  to  the  transfer  of  a 
large  amount  of  ecclesiastical  patronage  and 
property  to  monastic  bodies,  which  again 
strengthened  the  connexion  with  Eome, 
many  of  the  houses  In  England  being 
dependencies  of  foreign  abbeys,  and  ex- 
empted by  the  pope  from  episcopal  juris- 
diction. 

III.  Some  of  the  changes  already  in- 
dicated as  traceable  to  the  Norman  Conquest 
combined  with  other  elements  gradually 
to  produce  discontent,  and  demands  for  re- 
form which  came  to  a  crisis  in  the  six- 
teenth century.  These  disturbing  influences 
may  be  ranged  under  the  following  heads, 
(i.)  the  continually  increasing  encroach- 
ments of  the  Papal  power  on  the  liberties 
of  the  national  Church,  manifested  in  a 
variety  of  ways,  as,  interference  with  the 
election  of  bishops,  claims  to  patronage, 
oppressive  exaction  of  dues,  exemption  of 
monasteries  from  the  jurisdiction  of  the 
ordinary,  interference  with  the  authority  of 
bishops,  and  even  of  the  primates,  by  the 
appointment  of  legates,  (ii.)  the  wealth 
and  splendour  of  the  higher  orders  in  the 
hierarchy,  the  increasing  complexity  of 
ritual,  side  by  side  with  the  low  moral  and 
intellectual  standard  of  the  parochial  clergy, 
the  monks  and  the  mendicant  orders,  pro- 
voking a  spirit  of  contempt  and  discontent 
amongst  a  large  number  of  the  people.  This 
manifested  itself  first  in  the  movement  of 
which  Wycliffe  was  the  leader,  and  the  half 
religious,  half  political  insurrections  of  the 
people  called  Lollards.  There  was,  how- 
ever, no  direct  outward  connexion  between 
these  protests  against  mediaeval  corruption  in 
the  fourteenth  and  early  part  of  the  fif- 
teenth century,  and  the  actual  reformation 
effected  in  the  sixteenth,  for  Lollardism, 
whether  as  a  distinct  form  of  heresy  or  of 
political  rebellion,  had  been  nearly  sup- 
pressed before  the  reign  of  Henry  VIII.  But 
the  feelings  which  produced  these  earlier 
revolts  against  ecclesiastical  abuses  con- 
tinued to  work.and  were  strengthened  by(iii.) 
the  ^reut  ad\'ances  made  in  learning  towards 
the  close  of  the  fifteenth  century,  and  by  an 


CHUECH  OF  ENGLAND 

increased  spirit  of  piety.  To  these  must  be 
added,  after  a  time,  the  influence  of  Lutheran 
books  and  tracts.  The  quarrel  of  Henry 
VIII.  with  the  pope  on  the  subject  of  his 
divorce  from  Catherine  of  Aragon  was  only 
the  occasion  which  brought  the  real  causes 
of  reformation  into  activity.  The  repudia- 
tion of  the  Papal  supremacy  at  once  removed 
the  principal  obstacle  to  all  changes  in 
doctrine,  ritual,  and  discipline.  The  sup- 
pression of  the  monasteries,  the  translation 
of  the  Bible  into  English,  the  compilation 
of  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer,  were  all 
accomplished  within  less  than  twenty  years 
after  the  rupture  with  Eome.  It  must  be 
carefully  borne  in  mind  that  neither  Henry 
VIII.  nor  Edward  VI.,  nor  any  of  their 
ministers,  had  the  faintest  intention  of  es- 
tablishing a  new  Church.  Their  object  was 
merely  to  reform  the  existing  national 
Church,  and  to  restore  it  to  a  closer  con- 
formity with  the  Catholic  Church  of  an 
earlier  and  purer  age.  "They  stripped 
their  venerable  mother  of  the  meretricious 
gear  in  which  superstition  had  arrayed  her, 
and  left  her  in  that  plain  and  decorous  attire 
with  which,  in  the  simple  dignity  of  a 
matron,  she  had  been  adorned  by  apostolic 
hands."  Legally  and  historically  the  con- 
tinuity of  the  Church  remained  quite  un- 
affected by  the  changes  effected  in  the  six- 
teenth century.  No  legal  deed,  or  Act  of 
Parliament,  or  Order  in  Council  was  ever 
framed  by  which  one  Church  was  disestab- 
lished and  another  set  up  in  its  place,  or  by 
which  the  property  of  one  Church  was  trans- 
ferred to  another.  The  succession  of  bishops 
and  of  parochial  incumbents  went  on  with- 
out interruption;  they  occupied  the  same 
Sees,  and  held  the  same  benefices,  and  de- 
rived their  emoluments  for  the  most  part 
from  the  same  endowments  after  the  events 
of  the  Reformation  as  before. 

The  restoration  of  the  connexion  with 
Eome  in  the  reign  of  Mary,  and  the  harsh- 
ness with  which  it  was  enforced,  only  deep- 
ened the  feelings  of  resentment  against  it, 
and  led  to  the  development  of  that  excessive 
Puritanism  which  in  the  reign  of  Elizabeth 
was  the  most  serious  obstacle  to  the  settle- 
ment of  the  Church  on  the  principles  of 
sound  and  moderate  reform.  There  were  for 
a  time  three  parties  striving  for  mastery,  (i.) 
those  who  thought  that  reform  was  being 
carried  too  far.  Many  of  these  relapsed  into 
Romanism  and  became  the  founders  of  the 
English  branch  of  the  Roman  Catholic 
Church;  (ii.)  those  who  thought  that 
reform  was  not  being  can  led  far  enough. 
Many  of  these  also  gradually  seceded  from 
the  Church  and  were  ultimately  absorbed 
into  other  communities ;  (iii.)  the  milded 
party,  of  which  Hooker  is  the  most  dis- 
tinguished representative,  who  were  Pro- 


CHUKCH  OF  ENGLAND 

testant  as  against  the  usurpations  and  cor- 
ruptions of  Rome — Catholic  in  their  ad- 
herence to  the  teaching  and  practice  of  the 
Church  of  an  earlier  and  purer  age.  This 
party  became  dominant,  and  maintained  the 
upper  hand  until  the  general  overthrow  of 
Church  and  State  in  the  great  lebelhon  of 
the  seventeenth  century.  After  the  Re- 
storation it  recovered  its  ascendancy ;  and 
its  principles,  although  occasionally  in  abey- 
ance owing  either  to  apathy  or  the  tempo- 
rary prevalence  of  some  other  party  (as  of  the 
Evangelicals  in  the  latter  half  of  the  last 
century),  were  never  lost  sight  of,  and  in  fact 
were  steadily  held  by  a  long  succession  of 
the  most  learned,  able,  and  pious  men  who 
have  been  the  backbone  of  the  Church  of 
England  and  her  best  protectors  against 
Romanism  on  the  one  hand  and  the  mani- 
fold varieties  of  Protestant  dissent  on  the 
other.  And  the  strengthening  and  deepen- 
ing of  these  principles  has  been  the  main 
result  of  what  was  called  the  Tractarian 
movement  which  began  at  Oxford  about 
fifty  years  ago.  The  consequence  is  that 
the  party  known  as  the  high  Anglican  is  by 
far  the  largest,  the  most  active,  and  the  most 
progressive  in  the  Church  of  England  at  the 
present  day. 

Several  provisions  have  been  made  by  the 
civil  law  for  the  safeguard  of  the  doctrine 
and  discipline  of  the  Church  of  England. 
By  12  &  13  of  William  III.  c.  2,  s.  3,  it  is 
enacted  that  whoever  shall  come  into  pos- 
session of  the  Crown  of  England  shall  join 
in  communion  with  the  Church  of  England 
as  by  law  established.  By  1  Will.  III.  c.  6, 
an  oath  shall  be  administered  to  the 
sovereign  at  his  coronation  that  he  will  to 
the  utmost  of  his  power  maintain  the  laws 
of  God,  the  true  profession  of  the  Grospel, 
and  Protestant  reformed  religion  established 
by  law,  and  will  preserve  unto  the  bishops 
and  clergy  of  this  realm,  and  to  the  churches 
committed,  to  their  charge,  all  such  rights 
and  privileges  as  by  law  do  or  shall  apper- 
tain unto  them  or  any  of  them.  By  "5 
Anne,  c.  5,  the  sovereign  at  his  coronation 
shall  take  and  subscribe  an  oath  to  main- 
tain and  preserve  inviolably  the  settlement  of 
the  Church  of  England  and  the  doctrine, 
worship,  discipline  and  government  thereof 
as  by  law  established,  (s.  2).  —  Bede, 
Sistoria  Ecd-esiastica ;  Bright,  Early 
English  Church  History;  Stubbs'  Consti- 
tutional History ;  Fuller,  Church  History ; 
Collier,  Eccles.  History;  Hook,  Lives  of 
the  Archbishops ;  Hardwick,  Church  History, 
2  vols.     [W.  R.  W.  S.] 

If  a  legal  definition  of  the  Church  of 
England  is  required,  as  it  is  sometimes, 
probably  no  better  can  be  given  than  that 
it  consists  of  all  the  English  bishops  and 
clergy  who  still  accept  the  Prayer  Book  and 


CHUKCH  OF  IRELAND 


171 


Articles  and  the  decisions  of  the  lawful 
tribunals  on  any  doubtful  points  therein, 
and  also  of  all  English  people  (including 
foreigners  residing  here)  who  profess  to 
accept  those  same  authorities.  The  Privy 
Council  decided  (rightly  or  wrongly  as  one 
may  think)  in  Merriman,  Bishop,  v.  WH- 
liams,  in  1882,  that  a  Colonial  Church 
which  expressly  accepts  the  Prayer  Book 
and  Articles,  but  not  the  decisions  of  our 
courts  thereon,  is  not  even  in  connexion 
with  the  Church  of  England ;  and  therefore 
it  is  necessary  to  introduce  those  words 
about  the  courts  in  a  legal  definition,  so 
long  as  that  judgment  stands.  The  defini- 
tion, at  the  beginning  of  the  preceding 
artiele  is  too  abstract  for  a  legal  one,  seeing 
that  the  standards  of  doctrine  and  ritual  of 
the  Church  of  England  differ  from  those  ot 
two  other  great  branches  of  the  Catholic 
Church,  and  that  it  might  be  disestablished 
any  day,  and  still  remain  the  same  Church. 
It  must  be  remembered  that  no  formal  act 
has  to  be  done  by  laymen  to  signify  or  make 
them  members  of  the  Church  of  England ; 
and  that  they  are  not  required  to  express 
even  a  general  assent  to  the  Prayer  Book  and 
Articles,  and  much  less  a  particular  assent, 
and  that  a  man  may  accept  them  all  and 
yet  never  go  to  Church  either  for  good  or 
bad  reasons.  Consequently  any  definition 
of  the  Church  must  be  liable  to  the  remark 
that  it  is  indefinite  as  to  the  persons  it  in- 
cludes, though  its  standards  of  doctrine  and 
ritual  are  as  definite  and  fixed,  as  they  are 
for  most  of  the  sects.  (See  Dissenters.)   [G.] 

CHURCH  m  IRELAND.  The  first 
teacher  of  Christianity  in  Ireland,  of  whom, 
we  possess  anything  like  a  trustworthy 
record,  was  Palladius,  who,  according  to 
Prosper  Aquitan.  (Chron.),  was  consecrated 
by  Pope  Coelestine,  in  431  a.d.,  to  be  the 
first  bishop  of  the  Scots.  These  Scots,, 
however,  are  described  as  being  already 
believers,  "  ad  Scotos  in  Christum  credentes 
«  »  »  primus  Episcopus  mittitur; "  but 
by  whom  they  had  been  converted  it  is. 
impossible  to  say.  Anyhow,  the  Gospel 
had  not  taken  much  hold  of  them,  for 
Palladius  found  them  so  barbarous  and 
ferocious,  that  he  soon  abandoned  the 
country,  and  crossed  over  to  North  Britain, 
where  he  died,  probably  at  Fordun. — Book 
of  Armagh,  fol.  2  a.  a. 

The  real  founder  of  the  Irish  Churcb  was 
the  celebrated  St.  Patrick.  His  history  is, 
of  course,  overlaid  with  a  great  deal  of 
fabulous  matter,  but  there  is  little  doubt 
that  he  was  born  in  Scotland,  near  Dtun- 
barton,  at  the  end  of  the  fourth  or  be- 
ginning of  the  fifth  century,  probably  of 
British  parents ;  that  at  the  age  of  sixteen 
he  was  carried  captive  to  Ireland,  and  after 
enduring    great    hardships    there    for    six 


172 


CHUECH  IN  IRELAND 


years,  escaped  to  Lis  native  cotmtry. 
After  some  time  spent  in  study  and  tra- 
velling, he  was  ordained  presbyter,  and 
having,  as  he  believed,  been  summoned  by 
visions  to  preach  Christianity  in  the  land 
where  he  had  been  a  captive,  he  crossed 
to  Ireland,  probably  soon  after  the  de- 
parture of  Palladius  (about  432  A.D.),  and 
carried  oa  his  evangelistic  labours  there  for 
many  years  with  great  success,  although 
in  the  face  of  considerable  opposition.  He 
died  about  490  a.d.  The  value  of  St. 
Patrick's  work  was  proved  by  its  fruits. 
During  the  greater  part  of  the  next  two 
centuries,  Ireland  was  an  active  centre  of 
Christian  learning  and  missiooary  zeal. 
St.  Columbanus  founded  monasteries  in 
Burgundy  and  the  Apennines :  St.  Gall  was 
the  apostle  of  Switzerland.  St.  Columba, 
the  apostle  of  Scotland  (563  a.d.),  was 
abbot  of  a  monastery  in  the  north  of  Ire- 
land, and  the  founder  of  mauy  others ;  and 
the  conversion  of  the  English  was  largely 
effected  by  men  who  had  been  trained  in 
Irish  monasteries.  In  the  eighth  and  ninth 
centuries  Irish  Christianity  and  civilization 
received  a  severe  check  from  the  incursions 
of  the  Northmen.  But  when  the  Danes 
themselves  had  become  converted  to  Chris- 
tianity, it  was  through  the  Danish  settlers 
on  the  east  coast  of  Ireland  that  the  Irish 
Church  was  brought  into  closer  connexion 
and  conformity  with  the  Church  of  Eng- 
land than  had  hitherto  existed.  The  see  of 
Armagh  had  been  founded  by  St.  Patrick, 
and  enjoyed  a  kind  of  metropolitan  rank, 
but  no  fixed  system  of  diocesan  jurisdiction 
seems  to  have  existed  in  the  early  Irish 
Church.  The  chief  administrators  were 
abbots,  and  the  appointments  both  of 
abbots  and  bishops  fell  so  completely  into 
the  hands  of  the  tribal  chiefs  that  the 
■offices  were  regarded  as  family  property, 
and  the  emoluments  were  frequently  given 
to  laymen.  But  in  the  reign  of  William 
the  Conqueror  applications  were  made  to 
Archbishop  Lanfrauc  by  some  of  the  kings 
and  bishops  in  Ireland,  both  native  and 
Danish,  for  advice  on  ecclesiastical  matters. 
In  1074  Lanfranc  consecrated  Patrick  arch- 
bishop of  Dublin  at  the  request  of  the 
clergy  and  people.  His  successor,  Donach, 
was  also  consecrated  by  Lanfranc  in  1084, 
and  his  successor,  Samuel,  by  Anselm  in 
1096.  The  occasional  consecration  of  Irish 
bishops  to  the  sees  of  Dublin,  Waterford, 
and  Limerick,  by  the  English  primates, 
goes  on  to  the  time  of  the  conquest  of 
1  reland  by  Henry  11. ;  and  it  was  regarded 
as  an  encroachment  upon  the  rights  of 
Canterbury  when  the  Pope  Eugenius  III.,  in 
1151,  sent  a  legate  to  Ireland  with  four  palls 
for  the  establishment  of  four  archbishoprics, 
Armagh,  Dublin,  Cashel,  and  Tuam,  and 


CHURCH  IN  IRELAND 

decreed  that  each  metropolitan  was  to  have 
five  suffragans. 

The  conquest  of  Ireland  by  Henry  II. 
was  viewed  with  contentment  by  the 
hierarchy,  because  it  offered  a  hope  of 
escape  from  the  tyranny  of  the  native  tribal 
chiettains  by  bringing  the  Church  into  a 
closer  and  more  vital  connexion  with  the 
Church  of  Home.  At  the  synod  of  Cashel, 
in  1171,  it  was  resolved  that  the  Church  of 
Ireland  should  in  eveiy  respect  be  conformed 
to  the  model  of  the  Church  of  England. 

The  invasion  of  Ireland  by  Henry  was 
undertaken  with  the  express  sanction  of  the 
pope  (Adrian  IV.),  who  claimed  a  right  to 
dispose  of  all  islands  "  upon  which  Christ, 
the  sun  of  righteousness,  has  shined." 

And  thus  the  origin  of  English  rule, 
which  the  Irish  people  have  always  detested, 
is  due  to  the  head  of  the  Roman  Church,  to 
which  they  have  been  always  warmly 
attached.  Unfortunately,  the  English  did 
not  follow  up  their  first  occupation  of  the 
country  by  a  complete  subjugation  of  it, 
similar  to  that  which  the  Normans  had 
effected  in  England,  nor  by  wise  and 
humane  legislation ;  so  that  the  people  were 
neither  subdued  nor  conciliated.  Outside 
the  Pale,  a  small  district  near  Dublin,  the 
English  exercised  little  real  authority, 
either  in  civil  or  religious  matters.  Those 
who  settled  beyond  the  Pale  adopted  Irish 
habits  of  life,  and  shared  in  time  all  their 
animosity  against  the  English  rule ;  it  was 
indeed  a  common  saying  that  they  became 
"  Hibernis  ipsis  Hibemiores."  Efforts  were 
made  in  the  thirteenth  and  fourteenth 
centuries  to  enforce  the  English  supremacy 
bj'  a  variety  of  measures,  civil  and  eccle- 
siastical, which  only  served  to  exasperate 
the  natural  antagonism  between  the  two 
races.  Englishmen  were  put  into  the  sees, 
and  nearly  all  the  highest  oflSces  of  the 
Church  and  the  monasteries  were  filled 
with  Cistercians,  or  Augustinians,  imported 
from  England  or  Normandy;  it  was  made 
highly  penal  to  present  an  Irishman  to  an 
ecclesiastical  benefice,  or  to  receive  him 
into  a  monastic  house,  unless  he  produced 
a  charter  of  naturalization,  and  conformed 
to  all  English  usages,  civil  and  religious; 
the  English  were  forbidden  to  marry  into 
Irish  families,  or  to  stand  as  sponsors  for 
Irish  children.  The  alien  hierarchy  thus 
planted  in  the  midst  of  a  hostile  people 
sought  to  maintain  their  independence,  both 
of  the  native  chiefs  and  English  lords,  by 
cultivating  a  close  alliance  with  the  Roman 
See  ;  and  the  assertion  of  the  royal,  supre- 
macy by  Henry  VIII.  was  stoutly  resisted 
by  most  of  the  Irish  bishops,  although  ac- 
quiesced in  by  the  majority  of  the  laity. 
The  royal  claims  were  supported  by  Browne, 
archbishop  of  Dublin,  formerly  provincial 


CHURCH  IN  IRELAND 

of  the  English  Augustinian  friars,  but 
Cromer,  archbishop  of  Armagh,  was  the 
leader  of  the  opposition,  which  was  pro- 
moted by  the  agents  of  the  pope,  who  also 
Instigated  some  of  the  disaffected  chieftains 
to  try  and  regain  their  independence  by 
rising  on  behalf  of  the  Papal  claims. 
Nevertheless  the  Irish  Parliament  recog- 
nised the  royal  supremacy  in  1537 ;  the 
monasteries  were  dissolved;  and  it  was 
enacted  that  benefices  should  be  conferred 
only  on  persons  who  could  speak  English, 
and  that  English  should  be  taught  in  all 
the  parish  schools. 

The  first  Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI.  was, 
after  some  opposition,  accepted,  and  used 
for  the  first  time  in  Christ  Church  Cathe- 
dral, Dublin,  on  Easter-day,  1551.  Dow- 
dall,  the  archbishop  of  Armagh,  who  had 
been  the  principal  leader  of  the  opposition, 
went  into  exile,  and  the  Primacy,  by  order 
of  council,  was  transferred  to  the  see  of 
Dublin.  John  Bale,  originally  a  Carmelite 
friar,  was  appointed  to  the  see  of  Ossoiy 
in  1553,  and  became  a  vehement  champion 
of  the  Reformation.  Under  Mary,  the  Papal 
authority  was  re-established  in  Ireland. 
Under  Elizabeth,  the  Acts  of  supremacy 
and  of  uniformity  were  passed  by  the  Irish 
Parliament  in  1560,  only  two  out  of  the 
whole  body  of  Irish  prelates  openly  dis- 
senting; but  unfortunately  the  difficulty 
of  translating  and  printing  the  liturgy  in 
Erse  was  found  to  be  so  formidable  that  the 
clergy,  if  ignorant  of  EngUsh,  were  still 
permitted  to  say  the  offices  in  Latin.  There 
was  no  translation  of  the  New  Testament 
into  Irish  before  1603,  and  even  then  it 
was  only  a  private  enterprise  on  the  part  of 
two  learned  bishops.  The  attempts  made 
in  the  reign  of  Elizabeth  to  civilise  the 
country  by  placing  the  whole  under  one 
system  of  law,  were  resented  by  the  sel- 
fishness of  the  English  in  the  Pale  and  of 
the  native  chieftains  outside  it.  The  revolt 
of  O'Neil  was  only  one  of  a  series  which 
disturbed  the  reign  of  Elizabeth.  They  were 
diligently  fomented  by  the  Popes  Pius  V. 
and  Gregory  XUI.,  and  strengthened  by 
intrigues  with  France  and  Spain.  The 
people,  being  very  ignorant,  poor,  and 
entirely  subject  to  their  hereditary  lords, 
were  easily  persuaded  that  Romanism  wsls 
the  only  true  form  of  Christianity,  and  that 
to  fight  the  English,  who  were  opposed  to 
it,  was  a  sacred  duty.  On  the  other  hand, 
the  revolts  were  suppressed  with  barbarous 
severity,  and  punished  by  large  confis- 
cations of  the  soil.  These  harsh  measures 
cannot  be  justified,  but  are  not  to  be  won- 
dered at,  considering  that  the  revolts  were 
made  under  the  sanction  of  Roman  pontiffs, 
who  had  issued  bulls  deposing  the  Queen, 
absolving    her    subjects    from    their    alle- 


CHURCH  IN  IRELAND        173 

giance,  and  i)romising  remission  of  sins  to 
all  who  should  rise  in  rebellion  against  her ; 
and  although  niisgovemment,  and  a  Ion" 
train  of  wrongs  may  be  pleaded  as  extenua- 
ting circumstances,  it  remains  an  unde- 
niable fact  that  the  Roman  Catholic  Church 
in  Ireland  had  its  origin  in  political  re- 
bellion, and  in  schism  from  the  ancient 
Catholic  Church  of  the  country.  The 
bishops  of  the  Reformed  Church  are  de- 
scended by  a  regular  line  of  succession  from 
St.  Patrick,  whereas  the  Roman  prelates 
derive  their  origin  from  the  pope  in  the 
reigns  of  Elizabeth  and  James  I. 

The  Irish  Church  unfortunately  became 
largely  infected  with  the  Puritanism  which 
in  the  reign  of  Elizabeth  was  a  source  of 
much  trouble  in  the  Church  of  England. 
In  1615  the  Irish  Convocation  drew  up  a 
series  of  articles  strongly  Calvinistic  in 
tone,  but  in  1635  they  accepted  the 
English  39  Arficles.  The  English  Prayer 
Book  was  translated,  but  it  did  not  obtain 
any  public  sanction,  and  was  very  rarely 
used.  In  fact,  the  Reformed  Church  in 
Ireland  never  became  the  Church  of  the 
Irish  people,  and  one  main  cause  of  the 
great  rebellion  of  1641  was  their  belief  that 
it  was  the  intention  of  the  English  to 
extirpate  the  Roman  Catholic  religion. 
This  conviction  was  deepened  by  the  action 
of  the  English  Parliament  after  the  out- 
break of  the  rebelUon,  when  it  voted  that 
no  toleration  of  the  Romish  faith  should 
henceforth  be  granted  in  Ireland.  Large 
tracts  of  land  were  at  the  same  time 
bestowed  on  English  adventurers,  who  had 
raised  small  sums  to  aid  in  the  subjugation 
of  the  country.  And  thus  the  insurrection 
became  a  fierce  struggle  for  religious  and 
agrarian  rights,  and  the  barbarous  cruelty 
with  which  it  was  suppressed  by  Cromwell, 
the  ejection  of  native  landowners,  and  sub- 
sequently the  iniquitous  provisions  of  tho 
Act  of  Settlement  embittered  the  hatred  of 
Protestantism  and  the  English.  During  the 
reigns,  however,  of  Charles  II.  and  James  II., 
the  country  was  gradually  becoming  more 
settled,  when  it  was  again  upset  by  the 
Revolution  of  1689 ;  the  Irish  naturally 
supporting  the  cause  of  James,  as  the 
friend  of  the  more  popular  Church. 

The  victory  of  William  extinguished  the 
last  hope  of  religious  equality  in  Ireland. 
In  Scotland  Presbyterianism  was  established,, 
because  it  was  the  religion  of  the  great 
majority  of  the  people.  In  Ireland  the 
established  Church  was  the  Church  of  the 
people  in  one  sense  only — that  they  paid 
for  it.  Its  adherents  were  less  than  one 
seventh  of  the  population.  The  real  re- 
ligion of  the  people  was  oppressed  by  penal 
laws,  which  surrounded  the  Roman  Catholic 
worship  with  the  most  humiliating  restric- 


174 


CHUECH  IN  IRELAND 


tions,  condemned  the  bishops  and  clergy  to 
poverty,  shut  out  the  'laity  from  every  kind 
of  political  and  municipal  office,  and  all 
the  learned   professions,   except   medicine, 
thus  paralysing  industry,  and  driving  the 
best  men  out  of  the  country.     The  tithes 
for  the  support  of  the  established  Church 
were  wrung  with  difficulty  from  a  reluctant 
And  impoverished  people,  and  consequently 
many  of  the  Protestant   clergy  were  op- 
pressed by  poverty.    All  the  best  benefices 
were  bestowed  on  Englishmen,  generally  as 
a  reward  for  political  services.     Many  in- 
cumbents lived  in  Dublin,  instead  of  re- 
siding   on  their  benefices,  and    owing  to 
pluralities  and  non-residence  large  districts 
were  destitute  of  all  pastoral  care.     Some 
of  the  bishops,  such  as  Bishop  Berkeley  and 
Archbishop  King,  were  men  of  whom  any 
Church    might  well    be   proud,    but    the 
majority    were    politicians     rather    than 
fathers  of  the  Church,  and '  most  of  them 
were  non-resident,  or,  if  they  did  reside  in 
their  dioceses,  lived  less  like  bishops  than 
luxurious  country  gentlemen.     After  the 
final  downfall  of  the    Jacobite    cause   in 
1745,  the  condition  of  the  Boman  Catholics 
slowly  improved.     The    penal  laws  were 
mitigated  in  1778.     Pitt  proposed  endow- 
ment of  their  clergy  in  1799,  but  without 
success.     In  1800  the  Act  of  tfnion  for  the 
two  kingdoms  was  passed,  and  by  the  fifth 
article  of  union  it  was  ordained  that  "  the 
Churches  of  England  and  Ireland  as  now 
by    law    established   be   united    into    one 
Protestant 'Episcopal  Church,  to  be  called 
'the  United  Church  of  England  and  Ire- 
land.' "     The  number  of  the  Irish  sees  had 
been  gradually  reduced   by  a  process  of 
amalgamation    from    32    to    22.     In    the 
year  1833  it  was  brought  down  to  12  by 
the  suppression  of  10  sees,  and  provision 
was    made   partly   out   of  their   revenues, 
partly  out  of  a  tax  on  benefices  above  £200 
a  year,  for  the  vestry  cess  (a  charge  similar 
to    church    rates),    for     the    building    of 
churches    and   parsonages,    and    the    aug- 
mentation of  small  livings.      The  greatest 
grievance,   however,   was    the    tithe ;    the 
■great  majority  of  the  tithe-payers   being 
Koman  Catholics.     It  had  generally  to  be 
■collected  by  force,   the  cost  of  collection 
often    exceeded    the    amount    raised,   and 
many    of   the    clergy   were    consequently 
reduced  to  the  greatest  poverty.     A  tithe 
bill  was    passed  in   1834,   by  which  the 
"tithe  was  to  be  converted  into  rent-charge 
payable  by  the  landlord,  and  in  the  same 
year  a  commission  was    appointed  to  in- 
vestigate the  general  condition  of  the  Irish' 
Church.     In  the  following  year  Lord  John 
Piussell  moved  that  the  temporalities  of  the 
Irish   Church   should  be   considered   by  a 
.committee    of  the    whole   House,  and,  in 


CHUECH  IN  IRELAND 

committee,   he  proposed  that  any  surplus 
which  might  remain  alter  fully  providino- 
for  the  spiritual  instruction  of  members  ol' 
the  establishment,  should  be  applied  to  the 
general  education  of  all  classes  of  Chris- 
tians.     A  bill    embodying    this   proposal 
passed  the  Commons,  but  the  appropriation 
clauses  were    rejected    by    the  House    of 
Lords.     There   was  a  growing  conviction 
however  in  the  public  mind  that  an  esta- 
blished   Church,    which    had    existed    for 
many  centuries,  and  yet  comprised  barely 
one-seventh  of  the  whole  population,  was  in 
a  false  position.     A  system  of  "  concurrent 
endowment,"  by  which  the  Roman  Catho- 
lics, the  Protestant  Episcopalians,  and  the 
Presb3'terians,   would   have    been    propor- 
tionally benefited,  seemed    to    many   the 
most    equitable    way    of    redressing    the 
balance.    But  English  Protestant  prejudice 
rendered    any  measure  of  that  kind  im- 
practicable.    On  the  30th  of  March,  1868, 
Mr.  Disraeli  being  then  Prime  Minister, 
Mr.  Gladstone  moved  his  three  celebrated 
resolutions  in  favour  of  disestablishing  the 
Irish.Church.     After  a  debate,  lasting  over 
eleven  nights,  the  first  of  these  was  carried 
by  a  majority  of  sixty-five.      Parliament 
was  dissolved  in  the  following  autumn  ;  and 
as  the  result  of  the  elections  showed  that 
there  would  be  a  large   majority  for   the 
Opposition    in    the    new  parliament,   Mr. 
Disraeli  resigned,  and  Mr.  Gladstone  formed 
a    now    administration.     On    the    1st    of 
March,  1869,  he  introduced  his   measure 
for  the  disestablishment   and  partial   dis- 
endowment   of  the   Irish    Church.    After 
protracted    debates    the    bill   passed  both 
Houses,  and  became  law  on  July  26,  when 
the  royal  assent  was  given.     By  this  Act 
the  political  union  between  the  Churches  of 
England  and  Ireland  was  dissolved.    After 
January  1st,  1871,  the  Church  of  Ireland 
ceased  to  be  an  established  Ch\iroh,  and  its 
property,  subject  to  life  interests,  became 
confiscated  to  the  future  disposal  of  Par- 
liament.    The    ecclesiastical    courts    were 
abolished,  but  the  ecclesiastical  laws,  arti- 
cles, &o.,  were  to  remain  provisionally  in 
force,   vmtil    modified  or  altered    by    the 
Church  itself.      The    Church   was    to    be 
governed  by  a  representative  body  or  con- 
vention of  elected  clergy  and  laity,  which 
the   Queen  was  authorised  to  incorporate 
with  power  to  hold  lands   and  other  pro- 
perty for  the  benefit  of  the  Church.     In 
1877   this  convention  (or  synod,  as  it  is 
called)  revised  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer. 
The  principal  -alterations  made  were  the 
following — (i.)  The  rubric  directing  the  use 
of  the  Athanasian  Creed  is  omitted,  al- 
though the  Creed  itself  is  retained,  (ii.)  The 
special  absolution  in  the  "  Visitation  of  the 
Sick "  is  omitted  as  "  unknown  in  ancient 


OHUECn  IN  SCOTLAND 

times,"  and  the  form  in  the  Communion 
Service  is  substituted  for  it;  yet  with  a 
curious  inconsistency  the  passage  in  the 
Ordinal  for  Priests,  "Receive  the  Holy 
Ghost,"  &o.,  is  retained  intact,  (iii.)  All 
the  lessons  from  the  Apocrypha  are  omitted, 
(iv.)  A  rubric  at  the  end  of  the  Communion 
Service  allows  the  words  of  administration 
to  be  said  to  a  whole  railful  of  communi- 
cants, "  provided  that  they  be  said  separately 
to  any  communicant  so  desiring  it."  How 
or  when  he  is  to  express  his  desire  is  not 
explained,  (v.)  The  "  Ornaments  Rubric  " 
is  expunged.  A  few  new  services  have  been 
added  for  special  occasions,  as  a  harvest 
thanksgiving,  and  consecration  of  a  chiirch 
and  biuial-ground.  A  body  of  statutes  and 
■canons  was  framed  by  the  convention  in 
1879,  too  numerous  to  be  quoted  here. 
The  36th  canon  forbids  the  erection  of  a 
cross,  ornamental  or  otherwise,  on  the  com- 
munion table,  or  on  the  covering  thereof, 
nor  shall  a  cross  be  erected  or  depicted  on 
the  wall  or  other  structure  behind  the 
communion  table  " ;  and  there  are  some  other 
regulations  respecting  public  worship  which 
it  is  to  be  hoped  wiU  some  day  be  modified 
under  the  influence  of  a  larger  and  more 
tolerant  spirit.  Meanwhile,  in  all  the  most 
essential  and  vital  articles  of  the  faith,  the 
Church  of  Ireland  may  still  be  regarded  as 
in  full  communion  with  the  Church  of 
England. — Haddan  and  Stubbs,  vol.  ii.  pt.  2 ; 
:Soames'  Mosheim  (Stubbs' Edition),  vol.  iii. ; 
Hardwick's  History  of  the  Reformation; 
Eccles.  Histories  of  Ireland,  by  Brenan 
(Rom.  Cath.);  Mant  (Prot.  Episc);  Reid 
and  KUlen's  (Presbyterian) ;  Lecky's  Hist, 
of  England,  vol.  ii.,  chaps,  vi.  and  vii.) 

[W.  R.  W.  S.] 
CHURCH  m  SCOTLAND.  In  speaking 
of  the  origin  of  the  Church  in  Scotland,  it 
must  he  borne  in  mind  that  the  Scots  did 
not  migrate  from  Ireland  into  North  Britain 
tefore  the  beginning  of  the  6th  century,  and 
that  they  then  occupied  only  a  small  part  of 
the  country,  which  afterwards  was  called  by 
their  name.  The  first  founder  of  the 
.Scottish  Church,  strictly  speaking,  was  St, 
Columba,  who  crossed  from  Ireland  in  563, 
biut  it  may  be  convenient  just  to  glance  at 
some  earlier  missionary  efforts  north  of  the 
Tweed,  partly  because  they  prepared  the  way 
for  St.  Columba's  work,  and  partly  because 
the  regions  in  which  they  were  carried  on 
ultimately  became  incorporated  with  the 
kingdom  of  Scotland.  Passing  by  some 
"vague  traditions  respecting  the  conversion  of 
North  Britain  in  the  third  century,  the  first 
trustworthy  fact  to  start  from  is  the  mission 
of  St.  Ninian  early  in  the  fifth  century.  He 
was  bom  probably  in  Galloway  or  Cumber- 
land, of  Christian  parents,  visited  Rome, 
■was  trained  in  the.doctrine  and  discipline  of 


CHUECH  IN  SCOTLAND        175 

the  Roman  Church,  consecrated  bishop  by 
Pope  Siricius  a.d.  397,  and  returning  to  his 
native  country,  built  a  church  of  stone  at 
Candida  Casa  (Whitehorn)  and  founded  a 
monastery  there.  He  laboured  first  amongst 
the  Britons  in  the  province  ofValentia — the 
country  between  the  two  Roman  walls — and 
afterwards  converted  the  Southern  Picts,  the 
people  who  dwelt  between  the  Grampians 
and  the  Forth. — Bede,  iii.  4 ;  iv.  26. 

St.  Ninian's  work  was  carried  on  after  his 
death  (circa  432)  by  Palladius,  a  Roman 
missionary  who  had  accompanied  Germanus 
and  Lupus  to  Britain  for  the  suppression  of 
Pelagianism,  and  had  afterwards  crossed  to 
Ireland,  but  not  being  successful  in  his 
missionary  efforts  there,  went  over  to 
North  Britain  and  settled  at  Pordun  in  the 
Mearns.  He  and  his  disciples  and  successors, 
St.  Serf,  St.  Teman,  and  St.  Kentigern, 
strengthened  and  extended  the  work  which 
Ninian  had  begun.  Kentigern  was  con- 
temporary with  St.  Columba,  and  the  two 
missionary  abbots  met  near  the  site  of  the 
modern  Glasgow  and  exchanged  pastoral 
staves  in  token  of  friendship.  St.  Columba, 
abbot  of  Durrow  in  Ireland,  was  connected 
by  birth  with  the  reigning  prince  of  the 
Dalriad  Scots,  who  early  in  the  sixth  century 
had  crossed  from  Ireland  and  settled  in 
.Argyllshire.  In  563  Columba  arrived  with 
twelve  companions  and  established  his 
monastery  in  lona,  which  had  been  probably 
given  him  by  the  Scottish  prince  Conal.  A 
small  wooden  church  and  a  few  wretched 
huts  clustering  round  it  in  the  little  storm- 
beat  island  formed  the  htimble  germ  from 
which  the  Church  of  Scotland  sprang.  St. 
Columba  and  his  companioiis  laboured  with 
impartial  zeal  amongst  the  Scots,  the  Picts, 
and  the  English  of  Northumbria.  The 
Northern  Picts  were  now  first  converted  to 
the  faith,  and  lona  became  the  Christian 
metropohs  of  their  kingdom  as  well  as  of  the 
Dalriad  Scots.  St.  Columba  died  June  9, 
597,  aged  76,  very  soon  after  the  landing  of 
St.  Augustine  in  Kent. 

After  the  defeat  of  .^thelfrith,  king  of 
Northumbria,  in  617,  by  Redwald,  king  of 
the  East  Angles,  his  sons  took  refuge  at 
lona,  and  this  led  to  a  close  connexion 
between  the  Scotch  monastery  and  the 
Northumbrian  kingdom,  for  when  one  of 
the  exiles,  Oswald,  became  king  in  635,  he 
applied  to  lona  for  an  evangelist  to  teach 
his  people  Christianity,  and  the  holy  Aidan 
was  sent,  who  fixed  his  see  at  Lindisfarne. 
This  again  afterwards  led  to  missionaries  of 
Scottish  origin  or  training  being  sent  into 
the  midland  and  eastern  parts  of  England, 
so  that  we  may  say  the  influence  of  the 
Scottish  Church  was  felt  from  the  Orkneys 
to  the  Thames. 

Early  in  the  9th  century  the  Danes  began 


176 


CHUECH  IN  SCOTLAND 


to  lavage  the  west  coast  of  Scotland.  In 
825  they  attacked  lona  and  murdered  an 
abbot  as  he  was  ofBciating  at  the  altar. 
The  relics  of  St.  Columba,  however,  had 
already  been  removed.  For  some  years 
they  were  carried  about  from  place  to 
place  for  safety,  but  after  the  union  of  the 
Picts  and  Scots  imder  one  king,  Kenneth 
MacAlpin,  in  843,  they  were  settled  at 
Dunkeld,  which  became  the  ecclesiastical 
metropolis  of  North  Britain  about  849,  and 
so  remained  vmtil  905,  when  the  primacy 
was  transferred  to  St.  Andrew's. 

The  Church  thus  established  in  Scotland 
was  remarkably  independent  of  the  See  of 
Rome.  It  was  in  agreement,  however,  with 
the  Western  Church  on  all  vital  points  of 
doctrine,  but  differed  from  it  in  the  mode  of 
reckoning  Easter,  in  the  fashion  of  the  ton- 
sure, and  in  some  few  liturgical  matters : 
and  the  greatest  peculiarity  of  all  was  the 
supremacy  of  the  abbots.  They  were  the 
chief  rulers  of  the  Church,  the  bishops  being 
subordinate  to  them  except  in  the  discharge 
of  purely  episcopal  functions  such  as  ordi- 
nation and  comfirmation.  The  bishops  had 
not  fixed  dioceses,  and  the  succession  seems 
to  have  been  one  of  the  order  only,  not  of 
jurisdiction  within  prescribed  limits. 

These  peculiarities  were  abolished  by 
King  Malcolm  Canmore  and  his  English 
wife  Margaret,  the  granddaughter  of  Edmund 
Ironside,  in  the  11th  century  (1070-1089), 
with  the  advice  and  assistance  of  Lanfranc 
archbishop  of  Canterbury.  An  irregular 
order  of  clergy  called  Keledei  (contracted 
into  Culdees)  who  were  for  the  most  part 
married  men  and  transmitted  their  ecclesi- 
astical property  to  their  families,  were 
gradually  suppressed  and  their  places  sup- 
plied by  properly  organised  bodies  of  monks 
or  canons. 

David  (afterwards  canonised),  the  son  of 
Malcolm  and  Margaret,  carried  on  the  work 
which  his  parents  had  begun.  He  founded 
the  Abbey  of  Holyrood  and  many  other 
monastic  houses,  and  revived  or  established 
several  episcopal  sees,  including  Dunblane, 
Brechin,  Aberdeen,  Boss,  Caithness,  and 
Glasgow.  When  he  died  in  1153  the 
organisation  of  the  Scottish  Church  had 
been  brought  into  conformity  with  that  of 
the  rest  of  Western  Christendom.  The 
claim  for  metropolitan  rights  over  Scotland 
was  disputed  during  the  twelfth  century 
between  York  and  Canterbury  until  Pope 
Clement  III.  took  advantage  of  the  strife  to 
assert  his  own  supremacy,  and  declared  the 
Scottish  Church  (in  1188)  to  be  directly 
dependent  on  the  Roman  See  and  on  that 
alone. 

In  the  thirteenth  and  fourteenth  centuries 
the  clergy  took  an  active  part  in  the 
national  struggle  against  England,  and  in  the 


CHUECH  IN  SCOTLAND 

succeeding  conflicts  between  the  kings  and 
the  nobility  they  invariably  supported  the 
Crown.  Their  active  participation  in  war 
and  secular  affairs  lowered  their  moral  cha- 
racter and  weakened  their  moral  influence, 
but  increased  their  pohtical  importance. 
The  monastic  houses,  however,  in  Scotland 
as  elsewhere,  in  an  ignorant  and  barbarous 
age,  were  the  principal  centres  of  learning 
and  civilisation  ;  and  the  foundation  of  the 
universities  of  St.  Andrew's,  Glasgow,  and 
Aberdeen,  in  the  fifteenth  century,  was 
due  to  bishops  of  those  sees.  In  1471  Pope 
Sixtus  IV.  erected  St.  Andrew's  into  the 
Metropolitan  See  for  all  Scotland,  including 
the  See  of  Man  and  the  southern  isles 
(Suderei)  and  the  Orkneys  and  other  northern 
isles  (Norderei)  which  had  formerly  been 
subject  to  the  archbishop  of  Drontheim  in 
Norway.  Glasgow  was  made  an  archiepi- 
scopal  see  twenty  years  later,  and  for  a  long 
time  there  was  much  strife  between  the  two 
archbishoprics,  to  the  great  injury  of  the 
Church  and  realm.  In  no  country  did  the 
corruptions  of  the  mediaeval  Church  grow  to 
a  greater  height  than  in  Scotland :  and  in 
no  country  was  the  revolt  against  them 
more  thorough,  or  more  violently  conducted. 
The  issue  of  the  struggle  was  not  a  reforma- 
tion but  a  destruction  of  the  Church.  The 
Lollards  and  Wycliffites  do  not  seem  to 
have  been  numerous  or  powerful  in  Scotland, 
but  Lutheran  doctrines  soon  obtained  a  firm 
hold  upon  the  public  mind.  The  first 
person  put  to  death  for  teaching  these 
principles  was  Patrick  Hamilton,  in  1528 ; 
and  after  this  trials  and  executions  for  heresy 
were  frequent.  Cardinal  Beaton,  archbishop 
of  St.  Andrew's,  was  the  chief  promoter  of 
these  prosecutions  and  of  alliance  with 
France  after  the  death  of  James  V.  The 
reforming  party  was  aided  by  Henry  VIII., 
who  had  designs  for  marrying  his  son  Edward 
to  the  young  Queen  Mary,  daughter  of 
James  V.,  and  subjugating  Scotland.  An 
English  army  under  the  Earl  of  Hertford 
ravaged  the  Lowlands  and  destroyed  many 
of  the  great  abbeys,  including  Holyrood  and 
Melrose.  The  execution  of  George  Wishart 
in  1544  at  St.  Andrew's,  one  of  the  most 
powerful  and  popular  preachers  of  Lutheran 
doctrine,  exasperated  the  people,  and  Cardi- 
nal Beaton  was  murdered,  in  1546,  in  the 
castle  of  St.  Andrew's.  The  assassins  held 
the  castle  against  a  besieging  force  for  a 
year,  when  it  was  taken  with  the  aid  of  the 
French.  Amongst  the  prisoners  was  John 
Knox,  a  disciple  of  George  Wishart.  After 
a  captivity  ofnineteen  months  in  the  French 
galleys  he  was  released,  and  sojourned  for 
a  time  in  England.  He  paid  a  short  visit  to 
Scotland  in  1556,  after  which  he  resided  at 
Geneva  till  1559,  when  he  returned  to  Scot- 
land and  became  the  vehement  leader  of  the 


CHUKCH  IN  SCOTLAND 

reforming  party  tliere.  A  violent  sermon 
which  lie  preached  at  Perth  soon  after  his 
return,  against  idolatry,  led  to  a  riot,  which 
was  followed  by  a  series  of  destructive 
attacks  on  the  monastic  houses  in  various 
parts  of  the  country.  A  Confession  of 
Faith  and  a  Book  of  Discipline,  both  of  them 
based  upon  Lutheran  principles,  were  com- 
posed by  Knox  and  four  others,  and  ratified 
by  Parliament  in  1560.  The  Book  of 
Common  Order,  also  framed  by  Knox,  and 
containing  some  meagre  forms  for  public 
worship  and  the  administration  of  the 
sacraments,  supplanted  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer  about  .1565.  Episcopacy  was  prac- 
tically abolished  by  the  Book  of  Discipline, 
for  although  appointments  were  made  to  the 
sees  for  some  years  afterwards,  and  the  so- 
called  bishops  sat  in  Parliament,  they  exer- 
cised no  spiritual  functions.  In  1580  these 
titular  bishoprics  were  condemned  by  the 
General  Assembly.  A  second  Confession  of 
Faith  and  second  Book  of  Discipline  were 
compiled,  by  which  the  Presbyterian  system 
was  more  thoroughly  established,  and  these 
provisions  were  ratified  by  Parliament  in 
1592. 

James  VL,  however,  (L  of  England) 
succeeded  in  reviving  Episcopacy  for  a  time. 
At  a  Parliament  held  in  December,  1597,  it 
was  agreed  that  any  ministers  provided  by 
the  king  to  the  office  of  bishop,  abbot,  or 
other  prelate,  should  have  a  vote  in  Parlia- 
ment as  freely  as  any  other  prelate  in  times 
past;  but  the  General  Assembly,  held  at 
Montrose  in  1600,  passed  a  resolution  that 
each  one  of  the  persons  appointed  to  these 
offices  should  be  selected  out  of  six  nomi- 
nated by  the  Church,  should  receive  their 
instructions  from  the  Assembly  and  give 
an  account  to  it  of  their  proceedings.  In 
1609  bishops  were  admitted  as  presidents 
or  moderators  of  diocesan  synods,  and  con- 
sistorial  jurisdiction  was  restored  to  them. 
None  of  the  bishops,  however,  had  yet  been 
properly  consecrated,  the  old  line  of  succes- 
sion having  been  lost,  and  consequently,  iu 
1610,  three  were  consecrated  in  London  by 
the  bishops  of  London,  Ely,  Rochester,  and 
Worcester.  At  the  General  Assembly  held 
at  Perth  in  1618,  it  was  resolved  that  the 
Holy  Communion  should  be  received  kneel- 
ing; the  baptism  of  infants,  the  catechiz- 
ing of  children,  and  the  observance  of  the 
chief  religious  festivals  was  enjoined.  An 
Ordinal  was  framed  in  1620  on  the  English 
model,  and  the  English  Liturgy  was  used 
here  and  there,  but  Knox's  Book  of  Common 
Order  more  generally  prevailed,  and  alto- 
gether, both  in  the  worship  and  govern- 
ment of  the  Church,  there  was  a  curious 
mixture  of  Episcopalian  and  Presbyterian 
elements.  Charles  I.  was  unsuccessful  in 
his  attempts  to  recover  those  lands  of  the 


CHURCH  IN  SCOTLAND         177 

Church  which  had  passed  into  the  hands  of 
lay  impropriators,  but  he  settled  the  pay- 
ment of  tithes  on  an  equitable  footing,  and 
the  Perth  Articles  were  becoming  more 
generally  observed,  when  the  hope  of  a 
peaceful  settlement  was  frustrated  by  the 
ill-advised  attempts  of  the  king  to  force 
upon  the  Church  a  Book  of  Canons  published 
(in  1635)  merely  by  his  own  authority  and 
that  of  the  bishops,  to  revive  a  Court  of 
High  Commission  which  had  been  ex- 
tremely impopular  in  his  father's  time,  and 
lastly,  in  1637,  to  introduce  the  Book  of 
Common  Prayer,  and  enforce  its  use.  This 
was  the  immediate  provocation  of  rebellion. 
The  National  Covenant  framed  in  1638  was 
signed  at  Edinburgh  by  an  immense  multi- 
tude who  pledged  themselves  to  defend  what 
they  called  "  the  true  Reformed  Religion  " 
against  all  innovations  and  corruptions.  The 
king,  with  incredible  weakness,  consented 
to  revoke  the  Service  Book,  the  Book  oi 
Canons,  and  the  High  Commission,  and 
even  disallowed  the  observance  of  the  Perth 
Articles,  although  they  had  been  enjoined 
by  an  Act  of  Parliament.  The  Covenanters 
rapidly  increased  in  numbers  and  power,  and 
even  the  forms  of  worship  adopted  in  the 
time  of  Knox  were  abandoned  ;  Episcopacy 
was  condemned  by  the  General  Assembly 
in  November  1638,  and  the  bishops  deposed. 
The  king  visited  Scotland  in  1641,  sanc- 
tioned all  that  had  been  done  by  the  Cove- 
nanters, and  in  fact  established  Presby- 
terian forms  of  worship  and  government. 
The  solemn  league  and  covenant  by  which 
the  Scotch  and  English  bound  themselves 
"  to  labour  to  bring  the  Churches  in  the  three 
kingdoms  to  the  nearest  conjunction  and 
uniformity  in  religion,  and  to  endeavour  the 
extirpation  of  poperj-,  prelacy,  superstition," 
&c.,  was  drawn  up  in  the  General  Assembly 
and  passed  by  the  English  and  Scotch 
Parliaments  in  1643.  The  Confession  of 
Faith  and  the  Directory  of  Public  Worship 
drawn  up  by  the  mixed  Assembly  of  Scotch 
and  English  divines  at  Westminster  in 
1644,  were  approved  and  adopted  by  the 
General  Assembly  in  Scotland  in  the  fol- 
lowing year. 

With  the  extiuction  of  the  hierarchy  and 
of  an  orthodox  liturgy  and  orthodox 
standards  of  faith  and  worship  the  Church 
of  Scotland  ceased  to  exist.  It  was  revived 
after  the  restoration  of  Charles  II.,  when 
Episcopacy  was  re-established,  and  diocesan 
synods  were  constituted,  but  very  little  was 
effected  in  the  way  of  liturgical  reform. 

After  the  Revolution  of  1688  the  Scotch 
bishops  and  most  of  the  clergy  declined  to 
acknowledge  William  III.,  conceiving  them- 
selves bound  by  their  oaths  to  uphold  the 
house  of  Stewart.  They  were  cousequently 
deprived ;  and  in  1690  Presbyterianism  was 

N 


178        CHUECH  IN  SCOTLAND 

formally  established  hi  Scotland  by  Parlia- 
ment, and  the  Westminster  Confession 
declared  to  be  the  standard  of  faith.  The 
Church  was  never  completely  extinguished, 
although  reduced  for  a  time  to  a  state  of 
deep  depression.  The  bishops  lived  in  se- 
cksion.  In  1704  only  five  out  of  the  origi- 
nal number  of  fourteen  were  remaining,  and 
to  preserve  the  succession  two  more  were  con- 
secrated, and  again  two  more  in  1709,  but 
they  were  without  sees.  An  Act  of  Tolera- 
tion was  passed  in  1712  for  Episcopal  clergy 
who  were  willing  to  take  the  oaths  of  alle- 
giance and  abjuration ;  but  after  the  Jacobite 
rising  of  1715,  which  was  supported  by 
many  of  the  Episcopalians,  an  Act  was 
passed  (1719)  which  prohibited  divine 
service  being  held  where  more  than  nine 
persons  were  present,  unless  George  I.  and 
the  royal  family  were  prayed  for  by  name. 

With  the  death  of  Bishop  Eose  of  Edin- 
burgh in  1720  the  line  of  prelates  who  exer- 
cised any  diocesan  jurisdiction  came  to  an 
end,  and  the  remaining  bishops  then  formed 
themselves  into  a  college  which  elected 
one  of  their  number  to  be  primus,  but  with- 
out metropolitan  authority. 

The  Jacobite  insurrection  of  1745  was  fol- 
lowed by  very  severe  penal  laws  against  the 
clergy,  although  they  do  not  appear  to  have 
been  largely  concerned  in  it.  By  the  Act 
of  1746,  clergy  who  officiated  without  having 
taken  the  oatlis,  and  registered  their  letters 
of  orders,  or  who  refused  to  pray  for  the 
king  and  royal  family,  were  liable  to  be 
imprisoned  six  months  for  the  first  offence, 
and  for  the  second  to  be  transported  for 
life,  and  they  were  forbidden  to  celebrate 
divine  service  in  any  place  where  more  than 
four  persons  in  addition  to  the  household 
were  assembled.  The  numbers  of  the  Church 
were  greatly  diminished  by  these  harsh 
measures.  After  the  accession,  however,  of 
George  III.  in  1760  the  penal  laws  were  in 
abeyance ;  churches  began  to  be  built,  and 
the  clergy  ventured  to  discharge  their  duties 
more  openly.  In  1764  a  new  edition  of  the 
Scotch  Communion  Office  was  published. 
(See  Scotch  Communion  Office.)  In  1784, 
alter  the  declaration  of  American  Indepen- 
dence, Dr.  Seabury,  who  had  been  elected 
bishop  by  the  clergy  of  Connecticut,  was 
consecrated  at  Aberdeen  (November  14)  by 
the  Scotch  primus  and  two  other  bishops, 
legal  and  political  objections  having  been 
raised  to  the  consecration  being  performed 
by  English  bishops.  (See  Church  in 
America.') 

Prince  Charles  Stewart  died  in  1788,  after 
which  all  Episcopalians  agreed  to  pray  for 
King  George.  A  deputation  of  Scotch  bishops 
went  to  London,  1789,  to  petition  relief  from 
the  penal  statutes,  which,  after  considerable 
delay,  chiefly  owing  to  the  opposition  of 


CHUECH  IN  SCOTLAND 

Lord  Chancellor  Thurlow,  were  at.  last  re- 
pealed in  1792,  but  the  Act  declared  Scotch 
clergy  incapable  of  holding  any  benefice  in 
England,  or  even  of  ofiiciating  in  any  church 
in  England,  unless  they  had  been  ordained 
by  an  English  or  Irish  bishop,  and  this 
ridiculous  disability  was  not  removed  till 
the  year  1840,  and  even  then  not  without 
some  restrictions. 

The  Church  in  Scotland  is  administered 
by  a  college  of  seven  bishops  having  dio- 
cesan jurisdiction,  and  is  in  thorough  con- 
cord with  the  Church  of  England  in  doctrine 
and  forms  of  worship.  The  Scotch  Com- 
munion Office  indeed  differs  from  the  Eng- 
lish, but  like  the  English,  it  is  based  upon 
primitive  Catholic  models,  and  in  some 
respects  conforms  more  closely  to  them. 
(See  Liturgy,  and  Scotch  Communion 
Offlce.)  J.  Hill  Burton,  History  of  Scot- 
land ;  George  Grub,  Ecclesiastical  History 
of  Scotland ;  Hardwick,  Church  History. 
[W.  E.  W.  S.l 

CHUECH  IN  SCOTLAND,  LAW  OP. 
The  legal  disabilities  of  the  clergy  of  the 
Scotch  Episcopal  Church  since  its  revival 
have  been  due  to  two  causes;  first,  their 
having  been  non-jurors  after  the  Eevolution 
of  1688,  and  notoriously  siding  with  the 
Pretender  in  1745.  A  Toleration  Act  for 
them  had  been  passed  in  10  Anne,  c.  7,  but 
in  1746  and  1748  that  was  overridden  by 
two  Acts  which  prohibited  their  congre- 
gations except  under  clergymen  ordained  in 
England.  But  those  again  were  repealed  in 
1792,  provided  that  every  minister  pray  for 
the  king  as  in  England  and  take  the  oaths 
prescribed  and  subscribe  the  39  Articles. 
That  Act  still  prohibited  them  from  offi- 
ciating here,  as  it  also  did  clergymen  or- 
dained here  for  the  Colonies;  and  a  fortiori 
those  ordained  in  the  Colonies.  (See  CJiurch 
in  the  Colonies.)  The  second  cause  was 
their  adoption  and  retention  of  several 
variations  from  the  consecration  prayer  in 
the  communion  service.  The  first,  which 
was  called  Laud's,  of  1637,  reverted  sub- 
stantially to  the  first  Prayer  Book  of  Ed- 
ward VI.  which  only  lasted  three  years 
here.  But  the  second  Scotch  service  of 
1764,  which  had  no  royal  authority,  went 
still  further  backwards  towards  transub- 
stantiation  by  making  the  consecration 
prayer  run  thus :  "  We  most  humbly  be- 
seech thee  to  bless  and  sanctify  with  thy 
word  and  Holy  Spirit  these  the  creatures  of 
bread  and  wine,  that  they  may  become  the 
body  and  blood  of  thy  most  dearly  beloved 
Son,"  instead  of  the  1549  and  1637  form — 
"  that  they  may  be  unto  us  the  body,"  &c. ; 
while  all  our  Prayer  Books  since  1552  have 
had  no  prayer  for  consecration  at  all,  but 
only  the  recital  of  the  original  words  of 
institution  of  the  communion.    The  Scotch. 


CHUECH  IN  SCOTLAND 

Canons  of  1811  ordered  that  tlie  service  of 
1764  should  be  used  at  consecrations  and 
synods,  i.e.  on  their  most  solemn  occasions. 
But  some  new  canons  in  1863  practically 
leave  the  choice  between  that  and  ours  to 
the  minister  and  congregation,  and  now  ours 
is  to  be  used  on  the  great  occasions,  just 
reversing  the  former  position. 

As  there  has  long  ceased  to  be  any  doubt 
about  the  loyalty  of  the  Scotch  Episco- 
palians, and  as  their  clergy  must  not  use 
their  special  communion  office  here,  nor  are 
bound  to  use  it  at  home,  the  restrictions 
upon  their  admission  to  officiate  here  have 
been  more  and  more  relaxed.  The  Acts 
now  in  force  for  that  purpose  are  chiefly 
27  &  38  Vict.  c.  94,  which  enacts  that  no 
one  ordained  by  a  Scotch  bishop  may  hold 
any  benefice  or  curacy  in  England  without 
the  leave  of  the  bishop  of  that  diocese,  and 
without  subscribing  as  he  would  have  had 
to  do  in  an  Ei^lish  ordination,  unless  he 
has  already  held  an  EngUsh  benefice.  The 
year  before  that,  viz.  in  1863,  Bishop 
Trower,  who  had  been  consecrated  in  Scot- 
land, was  appointed  by  letters  patent  bishop 
of  Gibraltar,  which  recited  that  he  having 
been  already  canonically  consecrated  could 
not  be  consecrated  again,  and  therefore  the 
archbishop  of  Canterbury  was  only  to  ad- 
minister to  him  the  oaths  of  allegiance  and 
supremacy  and  of  canonical  obedience  to 
himself  as  metropolitan  (set  out  in  full  in 
Phill.  Ecc.  Law,  2228).  37  &  38  Vict. 
c.  77,  though  called  the  Colonial  Clergy 
Act,  1874,  relates  both  to  Colonial  and 
Scotch  clergy,  and  allows  any  "bishop  in 
communion  with  the  Church  of  England" 
to  ordain  by  request  and  commission  from 
.the  bishop  of  anj'  English  diocese  under 
15  &  16  Vict.  c.  52,  which  would  doubtless 
include  American  bishops  if  so  requested 
and  commissioned  (sect.  8).  The  Act  is 
drawn  with  the  usual  clumsiness  and  invo- 
lution and  comphcation  by  reference  to 
other  Acts;  and  it  is  in  form  mainly 
prohibitory,  though  practically  permissive. 
Sect.  6  annuls  all  appointments,  admissions, 
and  institutions  to  ecclesiastical  preferment 
here  which  are  contrary  to  the  Act,  and 
sect.  7  imposes  a  penalty  on  all  persons  offi- 
ciating contrary  to  it.  Sect.  3  enacts  that 
no  person  ordained  by  any  but  the  bishop 
of  an  English  diocese  (and  perhaps  Irish)  or 
his  commissary  (by  sect.  8)  shall  officiate 
■here  vnthout  the  licence  of  the  archbishop 
of  the  province,  and  without  subscribing 
this  declaration  adapted  from  the  Clerical 
Subscription  Act,  1865 :  "  I  assent  to  the 
•39  Articles  and  the  Book  of  Common 
JPrayer  ;  I  believe  the  doctrine  of  the  Churcfi 
•of  England  as  therein  set  forth  to  be  agree- 
able to  the  word  of  God ;  and  while  mini- 
.stering  in  England  I  will  use  the  form  in 


CHURCH,  EPISCOPAL,  IN  U.S.        179 

the  said  book  and  no  other."  The  bishop's 
licence  is  also  requisite  by  general  law. 
Nor,  by  s.  4,  may  clergymen  not  ordained 
by  our  bishops  or  their  commissaries  hold 
any  curacy  or  proferment  without  the  li- 
cence of  the  bishop :  i.e.  they  cannot  claim 
institution  on  merely  being  presented  by  a 
patron.  It  is  to  be  observed  that  this  in- 
cludes ordinees  of  Eoman  or  Greek  bishops, 
who  are  popularly  supposed  to  require  no- 
thing more  than  a  profession  of  conversion, 
or  some  kind  of  reception  into  our  Church — 
a  process  unknown  to  our  law,  though  forms 
of  it  are  given  in  some  books.  Whether 
the  words  of  the  preface  to  the  ordination 
services  and  the  Act  of  Uniformity,  "  unless 
he  hath  formerly  had  episcopal  ordination," 
were  or  were  not  intended  to  include  Eoman 
or  Greek  clergy,  they  have  always  been 
assumed  to  include  Eoman  ones,  and  were 
said  to  do  so  by  Lord  Lyndhurst  (but  obiter, 
or  as  no  necessary  part  of  the  judgment)  in 
R.  V.  Millis,  H.  L.,  10  CI.  &  Fin.  534  (the 
Irish  marriage  case).  The  late  enactment 
of  1874  seems  to  have  rendered  that  question 
immaterial  now.  Ordinees  of  American 
bishops  are  at  least  equally  included,  and 
the  condition  in  all  cases  is  the  licence  of 
the  bishop  of  the  dioceses  and  archbishop  of 
the  province.  Moreover  by  s.  5  such  foreign 
ordinees  may  have  a  perpetual  licence  from 
the  archbishop,  in  a  form  prescribed,  after 
holding  any  curacy  or  benefice  for  two 
years,  and  then  become  on  the  same  footing 
with  the  English  clergy.     [G.] 

CHUECH,  THE  PEOTESTANT  EPI- 
SCOPAL, IN  THE  UNITED  STATES 
OF  AMERICA.  Before  the  revolt  of  the 
colonies  in  America,  and  the  declaration  of 
Independence,  the  Church  had  only  a  pre- 
carious existence  in  that  country.  The  first 
band  of  English  colonists  who  landed  in 
Virginia  in  1607  were  Episcopalians,  and 
brought  a  chaplain  with  them  who  had 
been  approved  by  Archbishop  Bancroft ;  but 
a  body  of  Puritans  who  landed  in  1620  at 
Cape  Cod,  in  New  England,  were  the 
founders  of  a  community  which  was  exceed- 
ingly hostile  to  prelacy.  In  most  of  the 
charters,  indeed,  granted  to  the  several 
colonies  there  was  a  stipulation  that 
Christianity  should  be  supported  according 
to  the  forms  of  the  Church  of  England ;  but 
it  was  scarcely  possible  to  observe  the  stipu- 
lation, because  there  was  no  resident  bishop. 
All  the  colonies  were  nominally  subject  to 
the  Bishop  of  London's  jurisdiction.  Com- 
missaries were  appointed  by  him  from  time 
to  time,  but  their  authority  was  feeble  and 
dubious.  New  parishes  were  not  formed, 
churches  were  not  consecrated,  missions  for 
the  conversion  of  the  Indians  were  not 
established,  cTiildren  could  not  be  comfirmed, 
and     candidates    seeking    ordination     had 

N  2 


180    CHURCH,  EPISCOPAL,  IN  U.S. 

to  make  a  perilous  voyage  of  six  or  seven 
weeks  to  England,  where  many  of  them  fell 
victims  to  the  small-pox — a  disease  singu- 
larly fatal  at  that  time  to  persons  who 
crossed  the  Atlantic  from  the  West.  Queen 
Anne  had  intended  to  endow  four  bishoprics 
in  North  America,  and  a  sum  of  money 
derived  from  the  sale  of  land  in  St.  Chris- 
topher's had  been  set  apart  for  the  purpose, 
but  the  design  was  frustrated  by  her  death. 
The  Society  for  the  Propagation  of  the 
Gospel  in  Foreign  Parts,  and  many  eminent 
and  zealous  prelates,  including  Archbishop 
Seeker,  Bishops  Berkeley,  Butler,  Sherlock, 
TeiTick,  Louth  and  Gibson,  repeatedly  m-ged 
the  great  need  of  a  bishop  for  America  on 
the  attention  of  the  English  government, 
and  their  representations  were  backed  by 
petitions  from  the  clergy  and  laity  in  many 
of  the  colonies.  But  all  their  efforts  were 
vain.  "  Foreigners  occupied  the  throne : 
the  court,  including  the  royal  mistresses,  was 
ruled  by  foreigners :  and  the  single  object 
of  our  only  great  minister  until  the  appear- 
ance of  Pitt  was  to  defeat  the  measures  of 
the  Pretender.  The  imbecility  of  Walpole's 
successors  was  proved  by  the  loss  of  the 
Colonies." 

In  spite  of  all  disadvantages,  however, 
Church  principles  made  some  progress  in 
America,  and  a  decided  impulse  had  been 
given  to'  them  in  1722,  when  an  able  and 
learned  man  named  Samuel  Johnson,  the 
first  president  of  King's  College  in  New 
York,  seceded  from  Presbyterianism  with 
several  other  Presbyterian  ministers,  and 
crossed  the  Atlantic  to  seek  ordination  at 
the  hands  of  English  bishops.  After  the 
war  of  Independence  it  was  obviously 
impossible  that  the  ecclesiastical  connexion 
of  America  with  the  See  of  London  could  be 
even  nominally  maintained.  The  first  step 
taken  for  the  organization  of  the  Church  was 
at  a  meeting  at  New  Brunswick  in  May 
1784:,  attended  by  a  few  of  the  clergy  from 
New  York,  New  Jersey,  and  Permsylvania. 
The  union  of  the  Churches  throughout  the 
States  was  only  an  incidental  topic  at  the 
meeting,  but  it  led  to  another  being  held  in 
October  at  New  York,  in  which  some  general 
principles  were  agreed  upon  as  the  ground  on 
which  a  future  ecclesiastical  government 
should  be  established.  It  was  also  recom- 
mended that  the  several  States  should  send 
clerical  and  lay  deputies  to  a  meeting  to  be 
held  in  Philadelphia  on  September  27th  in 
the  following  year.  Meanwhile  the  clergy  of 
Connecticut  had  independently  elected  for 
their  own  bishop  a  man  named  Samuel 
Seabury,  the  son  of  a  New  England  .Presby- 
terian who  had  gone  over  to  the  Church. 
Samuel  Seabury  had  bren  a  missionary  of 
the  Society  for  the  Propagation  of  the 
Gospel,  and  had  received  an  Oxford  degree 


CHUECH,  EPISCOPAL,  IN  U.S. 

of  Doctor  in  Divinity  by  diploma  in  1777 
for  his  services  to  the  Ejiisoopal  cause  m  his 
own  country.  He  arrived  in  London  in 
1784  with  credentials  and  testimonials  from 
the  clergy  of  Connecticut  and  a  petition  for 
consecration.  He  was  cordially  received  by 
the  Bishop  of  London  and  other  English 
prelates,  but  they  shrank  from  the  respon- 
sibility of  consecrating  him,  partly  on 
political,  partly  on  legal  grounds;  more 
especially  aa  the  See  of  Canterbury  hap- 
pened at  the  time  to  be  vacant.  In  this 
perplexity  a  son  of  Bishop  Berkeley,  who 
had  inherited  his  father's  zeal  for  the 
cause  of  the  Church  in  America,  recom- 
mended Dr.  Seabury  to  apply  for  consecra- 
tion to  the  bishops  of  the  Church  of  Scotland. 
They  were  quite  willing  to  comply  with  his 
request,  but  the  abject  condition  to  which 
they  had  been  reduced  by  the  penal  laws 
which  oppressed  their  Church  rendered  them 
afraid  to  proceed  to  consecration  until  they 
had  been  assured  of  the  approbation  of  the 
English  bishops.  This  having  been  given. 
Dr.  Seabury  was  consecrated  by  three 
Scottish  prelates  at  Aberdeen  on  November 
14,  1784,  and  landed  in  his  native  country 
early  in  the  following  summer. 

The  independent  action  of  the  clergy  of 
Connecticut  in  obtaining  a  bishop  without 
consultation  with  the  other  States,  although 
not  altogether  approved  by  them,  was  not 
seriously  resented,  but  it  was  determined  to 
proceed  more  regularly  in  future.  The  first 
general  convention  composed  of  clerical  and 
lay  deputies  from  seven  States  out  of  thirteen, 
being  New  York,  New  Jersey,  Pennsylvania, 
Delaware,  Maryland,  Virginia,  and  South 
Carolina,  assembled  on  September  25,  1785. 
Articles  of  imion  were  passed,  several 
alterations  in  the  Liturgy  were  proposed,  and 
an  address  to  the  English  bishops  was  drawn 
up,  thanking  them  for  their  past  favours 
received  through  the  Society  for  the  Propa- 
gation of  the  Gospel,  and  praying  them  to 
consecrate  such  persons  as  might  be  sent 
over  for  that  purpose  after  being  duly  elected 
to  the  Episcopate.  In  June,  1786,  the 
convention,  met  again  in  Philadelphia.  The 
two  English  archbishops  and  eighteen 
bishops  had  meanwhile  returned  a  favour- 
able reply  to  the  American  address,  but 
objected  to  some  of  the  proposed  changes  in 
the  Liturgy,  and  to  one  point  in  the  con- 
stitution. The  latter  was  rectified  by  the 
convention  then  sitting,  and  the  former  was 
reserved  for  reconsideration  at  a  special 
convention  in  October,  and  was  then  ex- 
punged. 

Application  was  then  made  to  England 
for  the  consecration  of  three  bishops.  Dr. 
Provoost  for  New  York,  Dr.  White  for 
Pennsylvania,  and  Dr.  GrifiSth  for  Virginia. 
The  latter,  however,  was  too  poor  to  pay  the 


CHUECH,  EPISCOPAL,  IN  U.S. 

expenses  of  the  voyage ;  the  other  two  set 
sail  on  November  2,  1786,  and  were  conse- 
crated at  Lamteth  on  February  4,  1787,  by 
the  Archbishop  of  Canterbury,  Dr.  Moore, 
assisted  by  Dr.  Markham,  Archbishop  of 
York,  the  Bishop  of  Bath  and  Wells,  and 
the  Bishop  of  Peterborough,  an  Act  of  Parlia- 
ment having  been  obtained  authorising 
episcopal  consecration  for  foreign  countries. 
They  quitted  England  before  the  end  of  the 
month,  and  landed  at  New  York  on  Easter 
Day  (April  7),  a  happy  omen  of  the  resusci- 
tation of  the  Church  iu  the  New  World. 

In  July,  1789,  the  convention  again  as- 
sembled; the  episcopacy  of  Bishops  White 
and  Provoost  was  recognised,  the  constitution 
of  1786  was  revised,  terms  of  union  with 
Bishop  Seabury  and  the  northern  clergy 
were  happily  arranged,  and  the  Communion 
OfiBoe  was  brought  nearly  to  its  present 
form.  In  1790  Dr.  Madison  was  conse- 
crated Bishop  of  Virginia  by  the  Archbishop 
of  Canterbury  at  Lambeth.  There  being 
now  three  bishops  of  the  English  succession 
and  one  of  the  Scotch  io  America,  there  was 
no  longer  any  need  to  repair  to  the  mother 
country  for  the  continuation  and  extension 
of  the  episcopacy.  Accordingly  the  line 
of  American  consecration  was  opened  in  1792 
by  the  four  bishops  uniting  in  the  consecra- 
tion of  Dr.  Claggett,  elected  bishop  of 
Maryland.  In  1795  Dr.  Smith  was  conse- 
crated for  South  Carolina,  in  1797  the 
Eeverend  Edward  Bass  for  Massachusetts, 
and  in  the  same  year  Dr.  Jarvis  for  Con- 
necticut, that  diocese  having  become  vacant 
by  the  death  of  Bishop  Seabury.  From 
that  time  the  consecration  of  bishops  has 
proceeded  according  to  the  needs  of  the 
Church  without  any  impediment  to  the 
present  day.  Thus  was  founded  the 
Reformed  or  Anglo-Catholic  Church  in 
America  under  the  title  of  the  Protestant 
Episcopal  Church :  Protestant  as  opposed 
to  the  See  of  Home  ;  Episcopal  as  deriving 
its  descent  from  the  Apostles  through  the 
succession  of  its  ministers.  By  the  close 
of  the  eighteenth  century  it  was  in  a  state 
of  complete  organization.  It  was  still 
regarded  by  many,  either  on  religious  or 
pohtical  grounds,  with  jealousy  and  sus- 
picion; but  by  scrupulously  avoiding  all 
direct  interference  with  State  pohtics,  and 
by  strictly  adhering  to  its  principles,  it 
gradually  and  quietly  worked  its  way  into  a 
prominent  rank  amongst  the  religious 
denominations  of  the  country,  especially 
attracting  well-educated  and  sober-muided 
people  who  recoiled  from  the  extravagant 
and  absurd  doctrines  and  practices  of  the 
fanatical  sects  which  abounded  in  America. 

A  new  departure  ia  the  history  of  the 
Church  dates  from  the  Episcopate  of  John 
Henry  Hobart,  who  was  consecrated  bishop 


CHURCH,  EPISCOPAL,  IK  U.S.    181 

of  New  York  on  May  29,  1811,  at  the  early 
age  of  36.  This  remarkable  man  by  his 
great  ability  and  indefatigable  zeal  infused 
a  fresh  spirit  into  the  somewhat  languishing 
energies  of  the  Church.  At  first  he  had  to 
encounter  a  great  deal  of  obloquy  and  oppo- 
sition, but  by  degrees  friends  rallied  round 
him,  and  long  before  his  death  he  could 
reckon  amongst  his  supporters  some  who 
had  been  at  one  time  his  bitterest  opponents. 
It  was  through  his  efforts  that  the  General 
Theological  Seminary  was  estabHshed(1817- 
1821),  and  afterwards  a  Domestic  and 
Foreign  Missionary  Society  (1835).  These 
were  followed  by  ,the  diocesan  seminaries 
of  Virginia,  Ohio  and  Kentucky ;  measures 
were  taken  for  building  up  the  Church,  west 
of  the  Alleghany  mountains,  and  in  other 
parts  of  the  country  where  hitherto  it  had 
maintained  only  a  feeble  existence ;  and  in 
fact  the  American  Church  became  fi'om  that 
time  a  great  missionary  organization,  ex- 
tending her  operations  not  only  to  the  more 
remote  districts  of  the  American  continent, 
but  to  the  most  distant  parts  of  the  world. 

With  the  Church  of  England  she  has 
continually  remained  on  terms  of  the  most 
cordial  sympathy.  In  1841,  Dr.  Doane, 
the  bishop  of  New  Jersey,  preached  at  the 
consecration  of  the  Parish  Church  in  Leeds. 
He  was  the  first  bishop  from  the  American 
Kepublic  who  ever  officiated  in  England. 
In  1852,  the  American  Church,  in  token  of 
her  connexion  with  the  Church  of  England, 
and  of  gratitude  for  benefits  received  from 
the  Society  for  Propagating  the  Gospel  when 
the  American  States  were  part  of  the  British 
dominions,  deputed  Bishop  McCoskry,  of 
Michigan,  and  Bishop  de  Lancey,  of  Western 
New  York,  to  attend  the  third  JubUee  of  the 
Society.  They  were  warmly  welcomed,  and 
the  Bishop  of  Michigan  preached  the  Jubilee 
sermon  in  St.  Paul's  Cathedral.  A  few 
months  later  the  English  Bishop  l\ilford,  of 
Montreal,  assisted  at  the  consecration  of 
Dr.  Wain  Wright  to  be  coadjutor  bishop  of 
Eastern  New  York.  In  1853,  Bishop  Spen- 
ser, Archdeacon  Sinclair,  and  the  Rev.  Ernest 
Hawkins  were  deputed  by  the  Society  for 
the  Propagation  of  the  Gospel  to  return  the 
visit  of  the  American  prelates,  and  were  re- 
ceived with  great  cordiality  by  the  General 
Convention  of  the  American  Church.  In 
1867  a  large  number  of  American  bishops 
came  to  England  at  the  invitation  of  Arch- 
bishop Longley  to  attend  what  was  called 
the  Pan- Anglican  Conference  at  Lambeth : 
a  great  gathering  from  all  parts  of  the  world 
of  the  bishops  of  Churches  which  were  in 
communion  with  the  Church  of  England. 
Eighty  years  before  two  American  strangers 
had  presented  themselves  at  Lambeth, 
suppliants  for  consecration,  doubtful  of  their 
reception.     On   the  part  of  the  applicants 


182   CHURCH,  EPISCOrAL,  IN  U.S. 

and  of  the  arclitishop  there  had  been  anxiety 
lest  the  communication  between  the  clergy 
of  a  Republic  and  the  primate  of  an  Estab- 
lished Church  under  a  monarchy  should  be 
viewed  in  either  country  with  displeasure 
and  distrust.  In  1867  the  descendants  by 
Episcopal  succession  of  those  two  humble 
visitors  were  welcomed  on  equal  terms  by 
the  bishops  of  the  English  Church,  and 
alike  by  clergy  and  laity  their  visit  to  the 
land  of  their  forefathers  was  regarded  as  an 
honour. 

In  1884  the  centenary  of  Bishop  Seabury's 
consecration  was  celebrated  at  Aberdeen. 
The  Bishop  of  Connecticut  (the  fourth  suc- 
cessor of  Seabury),  accompanied  by  four 
other  bishops  and  a  delegation  of  Presbyters, 
came  over  from  America  for  the  ceremony, 
which  was  attended  by  all  the  Scottish 
bishops  except  the  aged  primas,  who  was  too 
ill  to  be  present,  seven  English  and  Irish 
prelates,  and  about  200  clergy.  The  services 
were  held  in  St.  Andrew's  Church — the  cele- 
brant on  the  first  day  was  the  Bishop  of 
Aberdeen — the  Scottish  office  was  used,  and 
the  same  introit  as  when  Seabury  was  con- 
secrated ;  the  sermon  was  preached  by  the 
Bishop  of  Connecticut.  On  the  morrow  the 
English  ofiBce  was  \ised,  with  holy  vessels 
which  were  presented  by  the  diocese  of 
Connecticut,  after  which  the  Bishop  of 
Aberdeen  at  an  Episcopal  Synod  of  the 
Scottish  Church  presented  a  pastoral  staff 
to  the  Bishop  of  Connecticut.  The  celebra- 
tion of  the  centenary  was  concluded  by  a 
service  in  St.  Paul's  Cathedral,  London, 
when  the  Bishop  of  London  celebrated.  Dr. 
Seabury,  a  grandson  of  the  bishop,  read  the 
Gospel,  and  the  sermon  was  preached  by  the 
Primate  of  All  England. 

It  may  fairly  be  said  that  there  is  no 
branch  of  the  Catholic  Chm'ch  which  stands 
upon  a  firmer  foundation,  which  has  been 
organised  on  sounder  principles,  or  which 
has  made  steadier  and  more  satisfactory  pro- 
gress than  the  Church  in  the  United  States 
of  America.  The  grain  of  mustard  seed  has 
grown  into  a  stately  tree.  In  the  course  of 
a  century  the  number  of  bishops  has  been 
increased  from  1  to  65,  who  preside  over  48 
confederated  home  dioceses,  and  missionary 
charges  in  America,  Asia  and  Africa.  The 
number  of  the  subordinate  clergy  has  risen 
from  190  in  the  year  1790,  to  nearly  4000. 
The  appro  imate  number  of  communicants 
is  350,000  and  the  total  number  of  lay 
members  may  be  roughly  estimated  at  about 
3,000,000.  Institutions,  societies,  guilds, 
sisterhoods  of  every  description  flourish  and 
abound.  The  Church  is  governed  by  a  body 
called  the  General  Convention,  composed  of 
the  House  oi  Bishops,  which  contains  all 
the  diocesan  and  missionary  bishops;  and 
of  the  House  of  Deputies,  consisting  of  4 


CHURCHES,  COLONIAL 

clerics  and  4  laymen  from  each  diocese. 
This  body  legislates  for  the  American  Church 
within  the  limits  of  the  United  States,  but 
can  make  no  alteration  in  the  constitution 
or  in  the  Liturgy  and  offices,  unless  the 
same  has  been  adopted  in  one  convention, 
then  submitted  to  all  the  dioceses,  and 
afterwards  ratified  in  another  convention. — 
Bishop  White's  Memoirs  of  the  Prat,  and 
Episcopal  Church  in  America;  Caswall's 
America  and  the  American  Church;  Life 
of  Bishop  Hobart,  by  J.  M.  C.  Vicar,  D.D., 
with  ijreface  by  W.  F.  Hook,  D.D. ;  Life  of 
Sam.  Seahury,  D.D.,  by  E.  Edwards  Beards- 
ley,  D.D.,  LL.D.;  History  of  the  Prot.  Episc. 
Church  in  America,  by  Samuel  Lord  Bishop 
of  Oxford.  For  account  of  American  Liturgy, 
see  under  Liturgy.     [W.  E.  W.  S.] 

CHURCHES,  COLONIAL  AND 
MISSIONARY.  The  earliest  attempts  at 
the  establishment  of  Colonial  Churches 
were  as  crude  and  unsystematic  as  were  the 
efibrts  made  to  found  the  colonies  them- 
selves. The  early  labourers  in  either  depart- 
ment did  not  realize  the  magnitude  of  the 
venture  on  which  they  embarked,  nor  where- 
unto  their  work  would  grow.  When  Queen 
Elizabeth  authorised  Sir  Humphrey  Gilbert 
"  to  take  possession  of  all  remote  and  bar- 
barous lands  unoccupied  by  any  Christian 
prince  or  people,"  the  foundations  of  the 
Colonial  Empire  were  roughly  laid  ;  nor  was 
the  religious  element  overlooked;  the  newly- 
gotten  possession  was  attached,  by  a  legal 
fiction,  to  the  manor  of  Windsor  or  Green- 
wich, and  the  propagation  of  the  Gospel  among 
the  heathen  was  set  forth  as  a  prominent 
obligation  on  the  colonist.  In  1633,  dis- 
turbances having  arisen  in  the  congregations 
at  Hamburg  and  Delft,  an  Order  in  Council 
"  Merchants  in  Foreign  Parts  "  placed  those 
congregations  under  the  jurisdiction  of  the 
Bishop  of  London  (vide  Heylin's  Life  of 
Laud).  This  was  extended  in  1726  by 
another  Order  in  Council  which  empoWred 
the  Bishop  of  London  "  to  exercise  spiritual 
jurisdiction  in  the  plantations,"  which  then 
included  the  American  States,  Nova  Scotia, 
Newfoundland,  Windward  and  Leeward 
Islands,  and  the  Bermudas.  Thus  a  sem- 
blance of  episcopal  rule  was  given,  and  the 
principle  recognised.  Without  the  cave  of 
the  State  the  very  origin  of  many  of  our 
colonies  compelled  the  settlers  to  the  pro- 
fession of  their  religion  :  it  was  the  very 
cause  of  their  leaving  their  native  land. 
The  Royalists,  "seeing  the  cause  of  their 
sovereign  daily  becoming  weaker,  looked  to 
other  lands,  and  thus  the  calamities  of 
England  served  to  people  Barbados,"  and 
that  island  the  Authorities  divided  into 
parishes,  laying  a  tax  on  every  acre  for  the 
maintenance  of  the  Church,  and  punishing 
by  fine  and  imprisonment  all  who  absented 


CHUECHES,  COLONIAL 

themselves  from  public  ■worship.  Puritans, 
on  the  other  hand,  in  the  early  years  of  the 
seventeenth  century,  covered  New  England, 
and  proscribed  "  Churchmen,  Quakers,  Ada- 
mites, and  other  heretics."  Virginia,  under 
its  special  Charter,  •was  a  Church  Colony, 
Baltimore  a  Roman  Catholic,  and  Pennsyl- 
vania a  Quaker  settlement.  In  1648  "  the 
Commons  of  England  assembled  in  Parlia- 
ment," acknowledged  the  duty  of  convert- 
ing the  heathen  in  New  England,  and  the 
New  England  Company,  which  was  founded 
by  the  Long  Parliament  m  1649,  still  exists, 
having  received  a  Charter  from  Charles  II. 
under  which  it  aimed  at  the  evangelization 
of  the  Eed  Indians.  The  same  monarch  estab- 
lished "  a  Council  of  Foreign  Plantations," 
whose  instructions  included  the  following : 
"  To  take  care  to  propagate  the  Grospel :  to 
send  strict  orders  and  instructions  for  regula- 
tingandreformingthedebaucheriesofplanters 
and  servants  ;  to  consider  how  the  natives, 
or  such  as  have  been  purchased  from  other 
parts  to  be  servants  or  slaves,  may  be  best 
Invited  to  the  Christian  F.iith." 

Towards  the  end  of  the  17th  century, 
when  persecution  was  ceasing,  the  religious 
enthusiasm,  on  which  many  of  the  colonies 
had  been  founded,  also  cooled,  and  the 
variety  of  creeds,  each  with  its  own  deterio- 
ration and  divisions,  was  a  matter  of  great 
concern  to  such  pious  men  as  Sir  Leoline 
Jenkins,  Robert  Boyle,  and  Robert  Nelson. 
The  time  had  come  when  the  Church  saw  the 
necessity  of  doing  its  work  in  more  syste- 
matic fashion.  Under  the  representations  of 
the  good  men  mentioned  above  the  project  of 
a  bishop  for  Virginia  was  nearly  accom- 
plished. The  bishop  of  London  had  sent 
his  commissaries,  Dr.  Blair  and  Dr.  Bray,  to 
Virginia  and  Maryland  respectively,  the  first 
in  1683,  the  latter  in  1695.  Their  repre- 
sentations led  to  the  establishment  of  the 
fcjociety  for  Promoting  Christian  Knowledge, 
in  1698.  In  1700  the  Lower  House  of  the 
Convocation  of  Canterbury  appointed  a 
Committee  "  de  Promovenda  Christiana  Ee- 
ligione  in  Plantationibus,"  and  Archbishop 
Tenison  made  a  representation  to  the  Crown 
which  on  June  16,  1701,  established  by 
Royal  Charter  the  Society  for  the  Pro- 
pagation of  the  Gospel  in  Foreign  Parts 
(q.  v).  At  this  time  the  West  Indies 
and  the  American  States  were  nearly  the 
whole  of  the  English  colonies.  Queen 
Anne  was  willing  to  sanction  the  establish- 
msnt  of  two  bishoprics  in  America  and  two 
in  the  West  Indies,  but  the  scheme  perished 
at  once.  The  demands  of  the  Church  in 
America  for  the  gift  of  the  episcopate  are  well 
known  (vide  Church  of  the  United  States). 
In  1784  the  declaration  of  Independence  and 
the  consecration  of  Samuel  Seabury  at  Aber- 
deen at  once  struck  off  thirteen  states  from 


CHURCHES,  COLONIAL  1S.3 

the  roll  of  our  colonial  possessions,  and  gave 
to  the  Church  in  those  regions  its  own  ei)i- 
scopate,  which  was  completed  by  the  conse- 
cration of  Drs.  White  and  Provoost  in  1787. 
The  same  year  saw  the  consecration  of  tiic 
first  colonial  bishop.  A  number  of  Loyal- 
ist refugees  had  towards  the  end  of  the 
American  war  of  Independence  made  a 
home  in  Nova  Scotia ;  in  1758  the  English 
Liturgy  had  been  legally  established  there 
as  "the  fixed  form  of  worship."  Eighteen 
clergymen,  on  March  5th,  1783,  petitioned 
for  a  bishop,  and  on  August  12th,  1784,  Dr. 
Inglis  was  consecrated.  In  1793  Canada 
was  detached  i'rom  Nova  Scotia,  and  the 
diocese  of  Quebec  was  formed.  In  1814 
the  bishopric  of  Calcutta  was  created  by 
Act  of  Parliament  (53  Geo.  3,  c.  155)  under 
severe  restrictions,  the  East  India  Company 
being  responsible  for  the  stipends  of  the 
bishop  and  archdeacons,  who  held  their  office 
during  the  pleasure  of  the  Sovereign  (an  ob- 
noxious condition  which  still  finds  place  in 
the  letters  patent  of  the  bishop  of  Calcutta) 
and  of  the  chaplains  who  served  under  them. 
In  1819  Parliament  legislated  respecting  the 
clergy  in  colonial  orders,  and  laid  restric- 
tions against  their  ministrations  in  England, 
which  were  modified  and  lightened  by  the 
Colonial  Clergy  Act  (37  &  38  Victoria,  c. 
77),  known  commonly  as  Lord  Blachford's 
Act.  In  1824  the  Sovereign,  by  letters 
patent,  established  the  bishoprics  of  Jamaica 
and  Barbados,  and  public  funds  were  charged 
with  the  payment  of  the  incomes  of  the 
bishops.  In  the  next  15  years  (1825-1839) 
there  were  founded  five  sees,  Madras  (1835), 
Sydney  (1836),  Bombay  (1837),  Toronto 
(1839),  and  Newfoundland  (1839).  Thus 
ten  bishoprics  in  foreign  parts  had  been 
founded,  of  which  six  were  wholly  dependent 
on  public  funds  for  their  continuance. 
This  closes  the  first  stage  of  the  Colonial 
Episcopate.  The  next  opens  with  the 
foundation  of  the  Colonial  Bishoprics  Fund 
in  1841,  and  ends  with  1852,  when  the 
Colonial  Episcopate  may  be  said  to  have 
been  complete,  the  whole  of  the  colonies 
being  under  their  proper  bishops,  although 
the  number  was  insufficient  and  the  dioceses 
were  in  size  unmanageable.  The  manifesto 
of  the  Council,  published  on  Whitsuii- 
Tuesday,  1841,  gave  new  life  to  the  Church 
at  home  and  abroad.  The  scheme  was 
statesmanlike  and  grand.  Before  the  close 
of  the  year.  Bishop  Selwyn  was  on  his  way 
to  New  Zealand,  and  in  twelve  years  (1841- 
1852)  the  following  sixteen  dioceses  were 
estabHshed :— New  Zealand  (1841),  Tas- 
mania (1842),  Antigua  (1842),  Guiana 
(1842),  Gibraltar  (1842),  Fredericton 
(1845),  Colombo  (1845),  Capetown  (1847), 
Newcastle  (1847),  Melbourne  (1847),  Ade- 
laide (1847),  Victoria  (Hong-Kong)  (1849), 


184 


CHURCHES,  COLONIAL 


Euperfs  Land  (1849),  Montreal  (1850), 
Sierra  Leone  (1852),  and  the  abnormal  and 
unhappy  bishopric  at  Jerusalem,  which 
under  a  special  Act  of  Parliament  was 
created  in  1841.  From  numbering  twenty- 
sis  in  1852,  the  bishoprics  in  foreign  parts 
have  now  reached  the  total  of  seventy-five. 
This  number  is  composed  of  sees  which  are 
subdivisions  of  older  ones,  and  also  of  purely 
missionary  bishoprics  in  countries  not 
under  the  rule  of  our  Sovereign.  The  first 
missionary  bishop  of  this  type  was  Bishop 
McDougall,  of  Borneo.  He  had  to  receive 
a  title  which  attached  him  to  a  portion  of 
the  empire,  and  was  consecrated  by  letters 
patent  bishop  of  Labuan,  and  thus  was 
technically  a  colonial  bishop.  But  the 
Eajah  of  Sarawak,  an  independent  sovereign, 
assigned  to  him  the  spiritual  charge  of  his 
territory,  and  in  Borneo  his  great  work  lay. 
In  1861  legal  difficulties  were  removed,  and 
at  once  piu-ely  missionary  bishops  were 
consecrated  for  Honolulu  at  Westminster, 
at  Capetown  for  Central  Africa,  and  at 
Auckland  for  Melanesia.  In  1863  a 
missionary  bishop  was  consecrated  for  the 
Orange  Free  State,  in  1864  for  the  Niger, 
in  1870  for  Zululand,  in  1872  for  Mid- 
China,  in  1873  for  Kafifraria,  in  1874  for 
Madagascar,  in  1879  for  Travancore  and 
Cochin,  in  1880  for  North  China,  in  1883 
for  Japan,  and  in  1884  for  Eastern  Equa- 
torial Africa,  while  the  bishop  of  Pretoria, 
who  was  consecrated  in  1878  as  a  colonial 
bishop,  has  become,  by  the  change  of  the 
relations  of  the  Transvaal  Republic  to  this 
country,  a  missionary  bishop.  Many  of  the 
colonial  dioceses  have  learned  how  very 
weak  a  reed  is  the  promise  of  Imperial  or 
Colonial  Treasuries  to  provide  Clerical 
incomes.  The  West  Indian  dioceses  have 
all  undergone  the  experiences  of  what  is 
called  disendowment,  or  more  properly,  the 
total  withdrawal  of  annual  salaries.  State 
aid  is  no  longer  known  in  the  Australian 
colonies ;  the  diocese  of  Colombo  enjoys  it 
only  during  the  life  of  the  existing  inoum- 
beuts.  Only  the  Indian  dioceses  and  the 
sees  of  Mauritius  and  Guiana  continue  to 
receive  public  moneys  without  challenge  or 
■warning  of  cessation.  The  efforts  which 
disendowment  have  called  forth  show  the 
great  power  of  self-support  which  even  poor 
dioceses  possess.  The  negro  flocks  in  the 
West  Indian  dioceses,  at  a  time  of  great 
depression,  have  secured,  or  are  within  view 
of  securing,  out  of  their  poverty,  with  help 
from  England,  the  permanent  endowments 
of  their  bishoprics,  and  are  able  to  maintain 
their  parochial  clergy  to  a  large  extent  by 
weekly  contributions. 

The  colonial  bishops,  at  an  early  date, 
saw  the  necessity  of  providing  for  self- 
government  on  strictly  Church  lines.     In 


CHURCHES,  COLONIAL 

1844  Bishop  Selvvyn  summoned  his  clergy 
to  a  diocesan  synod,  "  to  frame  rules  for 
the  better  management  of  the  Mission,  and 
the  general  government  of  the  Church." 
In  1850  the  metropolitan  of  Australia  and 
five  suffragans  met  in  convention  at  Sydney. 
In  1851  five  Canadian  bishops  met  at 
Quebec  and  represented  to  the  archbishop 
of  Canterbury  the  necessity  of  diocesan 
synods,  and  of  a  Canadian  metropolitan. 
In  1857  Bishop  Gray  held  his  first  diocesan 
synod,  and  in  1883  the  West  Indian  dioceses, 
having  already  established  diocesan  synods 
or  their  equivalents,  were  grouped  into  one 
province.  The  amount  of  autonomy  gained 
by  these  synods,  combined  with  certain 
legal  judgments  given  on  appeal  from 
South  Africa,  which  showed  tlie  colonial 
Churches  to  be  destitute  of  the  privileges  of 
the  Established  Church  at  home,  won  for 
them  the  liberty  which  is  enjoyed  by 
voluntary  bodies.  Foremost  of  all  was  the 
right  to  elect  their  own  bishops.  This 
problem  was  worked  out  by  the  Canadian 
Church.  In  1857  the  diocese  of  Toronto 
determined  to  cut  off  a  portion  of  its  terri- 
tory, and  to  constitute  the  diocese  of  Huron, 
to  which  a  bishop  was  elected  by  the  free 
suffrages  of  the  clergy  and  laity  in  synod 
assembled.  The  elected  bishop  had  to 
come  to  England  for  consecration  under 
letters  patent ;  but  in  1862,  when  a  further 
division  of  the  diocese  was  required,  the 
bishop  of  the  new  see  of  Ontario  was  elected 
and  consecrated  in  Canada  under  royal 
mandate,  and  thus  was  established  a  prece- 
dent which  has  never  since  been  disputed. 
In  1867  a  third  step  was  taken  on  the 
consecration  of  Bishop  Bethune.  The 
Crown  declined  to  have  anything  to  do  with 
the  matter,  the  Colonial  Secretary  declaring 
that  letters  patent  and  royal  mandate  were 
equally  without  value,  and  the  election  and 
consecration  of  Bishop  Bethune  were  con- 
ducted solely  on  the  spiritual  authority  of 
the  Church.  Provincial  and  diocesan  synods 
are  now  ever3'where  in  full  working  order, 
giving  cohesion  to  the  several  dioceses. 
The  Province  of  Canada  has  now  nine 
dioceses,  the  Province  of  Rupert's  Land  six, 
the  Province  of  British  Columbia  three,  the 
Province  of  New  Zealand  six  and  the 
missionary  diocese  of  Melanesia,  the  Pro- 
vince of  Australia  thirteen,  the  Province 
of  South  Africa  eight,  the  Province  of 
Calcutta  seven,  and  the  West  Indian  Province 
eight,  including  the  inchoate  and  unen- 
dowed dioceses  of  Honduras,  which  is  for 
the  present  under  the  charge  of  the  bishop 
of  Jamaica,  and  the  Windward  Islands, 
equally  without  endowment,  but  having  a 
separate  synod,  under  the  bishop  of  Barbados. 
It  is  probable  tliat  Australia  will  shortly  have 
separate  provinces  in  New  South  Wales, 


OHUECHES,  COLONIAL 

"Victoria,  Queensland,  nnd  South  Australia, 
but  the  bishop  of  Sydney  will  still  be 
the  primate  over  all.  These  sees  are  now 
wholly  or  partially  endowed,  with  the  ex- 
ception of  a  few,  which  for  the  present  are 
subsidized  by  the  S.  P.  G.  or  the  C.  M.  S. 
The  office  of  metropolitan  is  not  in  all  cases 
attached  to  a  particular  see,  but  is  settled 
by  election  in  Canada,  Rupert's  Land, 
Columbia,  and  the  West  Indies.  In  Africa 
it  is  attached  to  Capeto^vn,  in  Australia  to 
Sydney,  in  India  to  Calcutta,  while  in  New 
Zealand,  as  in  the  United  States,  it  devolves 
on  the  senior  bishop  of  the  province.  In 
these  dioceses  theological  colleges  and  even 
xuiiversities  have  been  founded  in  numbers 
■which  in  some  cases  are  in  excess  of  what 
prudence  and  necessity  demand.  In  India 
there  are  Bishop's  College,  Calcutta,  Vepery 
College  at  Madras,  the  Divinity  College  at 
Lahore,  the  Training  Institution  for  Natives 
at  Kemmendine,  Rangoon,  Caldwell  College 
at  Tuticorin,  and  the  Training  College  at 
Cottayam  in  Travancore.  In  America,  St. 
John's  College,  Newfoundland ;  Windsor 
College,  Nova  Scotia ;  Lennoxville  College, 
Quebec;  Trinity  College  and  University 
at  Toronto ;  St.  John's  College  at  Winni- 
peg ;  Emmanuel  College  in  the  diocese 
of  Saskatchewan.  In  Africa,  Zounebloem 
Native  College  at  Capetown,  the  Kafir 
Institution  at  Graham's  Town,  and  a  Native 
College  at  Ambatoharanana,  Madagascar. 
In  New  Zealand,  Christ  College  at  Christ- 
church;  in  Australia,  Moore  College, 
Sydney,  and  Christ  College,  Tasmania ;  and 
in  the  West  Indies,  the  old  foundation  of 
Codiington  College,  Barbados.  The  dioceses 
which  still  owe  direct  allegiance  to  Canter- 
bury are  Newfoundland,  to  which  is  attached 
Bermuda,  the  Falkland  Islands,  Mauritius, 
Victoria  (Hong-Kong),  Sierra  Leone,  Singa- 
pore and  Sarawak,  Gibraltar,  and  the  mission- 
ary dioceses  of  Madagascar,  Central  Africa, 
Eastern  Equatorial  Africa,  the  Niger, 
Honolulu,  Mid-China,  North  Cliina,  Jeru- 
salem, and  Japan.  In  all  these  vast  regions 
the  Church  is  working  on  her  own  principles, 
and  in  her  own  independent  strength, 
except  in  India,  where  there  is  a  body  of 
clergy  numbering  not  one-fourth  of  the 
whole,  who,  including  the  bishops,  are  paid 
by  public  moneys,  and  governed  by  Acts  of 
Parliament.  When  the  first  bishop  was 
sent  to  India,  the  whole  clerical  body  were 
chaplains  of  the  E.  I.  Company,  ministering 
to  the  civil  and  military  servants  of  the 
Company,  which  paid  them  their  salaries. 
There  are  now  more  than  620  clergymen  in 
India,  of  whom  one-third  are  natives  ;  but 
the  presence  of  a  salaried  portion  of  this 
body,  numbering  about  164,  hinders  the 
expansion  of  the  Church  and  the  growth  of 
the    Episcopate,   and   the   development    of 


OHUKCHES,  COLONIAL         185 

missions.  -Bishops  and  archdeacons  must 
be  chaplains,  and  be  paid  by  the  Government, 
and  more  bishops  are  not  sanctioned  by  the 
Government  except  as  assistants  to  the 
State  bishops.  Two  ■  such  prelates,  paid  by 
English  societies,  overlook  the  missionary 
work  in  South  India,  but  the  number  of 
bishops  of  this  tyiie  is  not  likely  to  be 
increased,  and  in  some  change  of  the  relations 
of  Government  to  the  Church  is  to  be  found 
the  hope  of  Church  extension  on  Church 
principles  in  Hindostan. 

This  sketch  of  our  Colonial  and  Missionary 
Churches  has  been  written  on  the  principle 
"  Ubi  Episcopus,  ibi  Ecclesia"  and  the 
historical  fact  is  that  the  extension  of  the 
Episcopate  is  the  extension  of  the  Church, 
and  therein  the  multiplication  of  both  clergy 
and  laity.  The  Church  in  foreign  parts  has 
now  147  bishops  (including  67  American 
bishops  with  five  suffragans),  7000  clergy- 
men, and  at  least  3,000,000  laity. 

The  following  list  gives  the  dates  of  the 
existing  colonial  dioceses,  and  the  names  of 
their  incumbents. 

1.  Nova  Scotia 1787 

2.  Quebec 1793 

3.  Calcutta 1814 

4.  Jamaica 1824 

5.  Barbados,  1824  (and  Windward 

Islands,  1878)       ....  1824 

6.  Madras 1835 

7.  Sydney  {formerly  Australia)     .  1836 

8.  Bombay 1837 

9.  Toronto 1839 

10.  Newfoundland 1839 

11.  Auckland  (formerly  New  Zealand)  1841 

12.  Jerusalem 1841 

13.  Tasmania 1842 

14.  Antigua 1842 

15.  Guiana 1842 

16.  Gibraltar 1842 

17.  Eredericton 1845 

18.  Colombo 1845 

19.  Capetown 1847 

20.  Newcastle 1847 

21.  Melbourne 1847 

22.  Adelaide 1847 

23.  Victoria  (China) 1849 

24.  Eupertsland 1849 

25.  Montreal  .......  1850 

26.  Sierra  Leone 1852 

27.  Grahamstown 1853 

28.  Mauritius 1854 

29.  Singapore,  Labuan,  and  Sarawak  1855 

30.  Christchm-ch  (N.Z.)  ....  1856 

31.  Perth 1857 

32.  Huron 1857 

33.  Wellington 1858 

34.  Nelson 1858 

35.  Waiapu 1858 

36.  Brisbane 1859 

37.  St.  Helena 1859 


186  CHURCH  IN  COLONIES 

38.  Columbia 1859 

39.  Nassau 1861 

40.  Central  Africa  (formerly  Zambesi)  1861 

41.  Honolulu 1861 

42.  Melanesia 1861 

43.  Ontario 1862 

44.  Bloemfontein  (formerly  Orange 

River) 1863 

45.  Goulbuiu 1863 

46.  Niger 1864 

47.  Dunediu 1866 

48.  Grafton  and  Armidale     .     .      .  1867 

49.  Maritzburg 1869 

50.  Bathurst 1869 

51.  Falkland  Islands        ....  1869 

52.  Zululand 1870 

53.  Moosonee 1872 

54.  Trinidad 1872 

55.  Mid-China 1872 

56.  Algoma 1873 

57.  St.    John's   (formerly   Indepen- 

dent Kaffraria)     ....     1873 

58.  Athabasca  (Old  Diocese,  see  75) 

now  called  Mackenzie  Eiver  .     1874 

59.  Saskatchewan 1874 

GO.  Madagascar 1874 

61.  Ballaarat 1875 

62.  Niagara 1875 

63.  Lahore 1877 

64.  Rangoon 1877 

65.  Pretoria 1878 

66.  North  Queensland      ....  1878 

67.  Caledonia 1879 

68.  New  Westminster      ....  1879 

69.  Travancore  and  Cochin   .     .      .  1879 

70.  North  China 1880 

71.  .Japan 1883 

72.  Rlverina 1884 

73.  Qu'Appelle  (formerly  Assiniboia)  1884 

74.  Eastern  Equatorial  Africa    .      .  1884 

75.  Athabasca  (New  Diocese,  see  58)  1884 

CHURCH  IN  THE  COLONIES,  LAW 

OP.  The  Colonial  Clergy  Act,  1874,  has 
put  those  clergy  practicaEy  in  the  same 
position  as  the  Scotch  (q.  v.).  But  a  late 
decision  of  a  small  and  not  very  weighty 
judicial  committee  of  the  Privy  Council 
affirmed  a  proposition  of  considerable  con- 
sequence to  Colonial  Churches  which  think 
they  are  in  connexion  with  the  Church  cf 
England  when  anything  turns  upon  those 
words.  It  was  decided  in  Merriman,  bishop 
of  the  so-called  South  African  Church,  v. 
Williams,  titular  dean  of  Cape  Town,  1882, 
7  App.  Cases,  484,  that  although  the  bishop 
■would  certainly  have  had  the  rights  he 
claimed  (to  preach  in  the  church)  if  it  had 
really  been  "  in  connexion  with  the  Church 
of  England,"  it  was  not  so  ;  because,  al- 
though it  expressly  adopted  all  the  standards 
and  formularies  of  the  Church  of  England, 
it  also  "provided  that  in  the  interpretation 
of  them  it  is  not  to  be  bound  by  decisions 


CHURCH  IN  COLONIES 

jother  than  those  of  its  own  ecclesiastical 
tribunals,"  i.e.  not  by  those  of  the  English 
ecclesiastical  courts  and  Privy  Council.  The- 
reason  given  for  the  judgment  was  that 
such  a  Church  might  excommunicate  clergy- 
men for  preaching  doctrines  which  have 
been  decided  not  to  be  ground  for  deprivation- 
here,  and  vice  versa.  And  yet  the  eccle- 
siastical courts  here  could  not  anyhow  be 
given  jurisdiction  by  a  Colonial  Church,  and 
the  Privy  Council  is  not  an  ecclesiastical 
court  of  appeal  for  the  Colonies,  but  only 
the  common  law  court  of  appeal  instead  of 
the  House  of  Lords,  and  it  was  so  acting  in, 
that  very  case.  The  great  case  of  Bishop 
Colenso  was  decided  on  a  mere  technicality 
about  the  letters  patent,  and  is  of  no  eccle- 
siastical importance. 

After  what  has  been  said  about  the  last 
Colonial  Clergy  Act,  1874,  it  is  mmecessary 
to  go  through  the  history  of  the  earlier  Acts 
for  providing  bishops  and  clergy  for  the 
Colonies,  and  the  gradual  extension  of  their 
privileges  here.     It  is  sufficient  to  say  that 
the  first  of  such  Acts,  24  Geo.  III.  o.  35, 
authorised  the  bishop  of  London  to  ordain 
subjects   of  other  dominions    without   the 
oath  of  allegiance,  but  they  are  not  to  offi- 
ciate in  the  king's  dominions,  and  the  Act 
made  no  provision  for  bishops.   Consequently 
the  Church   in  America    resorted   to   the 
Scotch  bishops  for  a  short  time.     But  by 
26  Geo.  III.  c.  84,  power  was  given  to  con- 
secrate foreigners  as  bishops  without  any 
royal  mandate  which  was  recited  to  be  re- 
quisite for  any  consecration  by  the  law  of 
England.   59  Geo.  III.  c.  60,  empowered  the 
archbishops  and  other  bishops  to  consecrate 
bishops  expressly  for  the  Colonies.    Acts  of 
3  &  4  "Vict.  c.  33,  and  5  Vict.  c.  6,  and  15 
&  16  Vict.  c.  52,  and  16  &  17  Vict.  c.  49, 
require  a  proper  testimonial  from  the  Colony. 
And    the    ordinees    of   all    the    Colonial 
bishops  and  all  others,  except  those  of  this 
country,   were    prohibited  from  officiating 
here,  except  by  consent  of  the  archbishop 
and  bishop  of  the  place  where  they  want  to 
hold  a  benefice  or  curacy.     And  this  was 
the  case  of  ordinees  of  Roman  bishops,  who 
can    claim    no    recognition    on    becoming 
Protestants  without    the    consent  of  our 
bishops  and  archbishops.     And  further,  by 
15_&  16  Vict.  c.  52,  and  16  &  17  Vict.  c. 
49,  the  Colonial  or  foreign  bishop  ordaining 
must   either  have  actual  jurisdiction  over 
some  diocese,  or  else  have  been  acting  by 
commission  from  an  English  bishop.     (It  is 
a  curious  specimen  of  legislation  that  tho 
first  of  those  Acts  only  mentioned  Indian 
bishops,  omitting  the  Colonial ;  indeed  all 
these  Acts  are  a  mass  of  confusion  about  on 
a  level  with    the  church   building   Acts.) 
The  Act  3  &  4  Vict.  o.  33,  s.  3,  expressly 
puts  the  bishops  and  clergy  of  the  Protes- 


GHUECH,  GALLICAN 

tant  Episcopal  Church  in  America  on  the 
same  footing  liere  as  those  of  the  Episcopal 
Scotch  Church. 

The  Act  37  &  38  Vict.  c.  77  (1874),  called 
the  Colonial  Clergy  Act  (hut  it  covers  Scot- 
land also),  repealed  the  whole  of  3  &  4  Vict, 
c.  33,  and  parts  of  several  of  the  others, 
as  already  stated  under  Church  in  Scotland. 
Either  by  accident  or  intention  the  licence 
from  either  archbishop  operates  all  over  Eng- 
land, and  it  is  not  revocable.  Of  course  the 
bishop's  licence  to  a  curate  is.  The  prac- 
tical result  is  that  no  one  who  "  has  had 
espiscopal  ordination "  (as  the  Act  of  Uni- 
formity says)  is  now  precluded  from  offi- 
ciating and  holding  either  a  curacy  or  a 
benefice  in  the  Church  of  England  under 
the  formal  licence  of  the  bishop  and  arch- 
bishop having  jurisdiction  in  the  place  ;  but 
no  clergyman  who  was  not  ordained  in  and 
for  En<iland  can  claim  any  right  to  be  so 
licensed  on  being  presented  to  a  living.  [G.] 

CHUECH,  THE  GALLICAN.  By  this 
name  is  to  be  understood  the  Church  in 
that  part  of  Europe  which,  after  having 
been  a  portion  of  the  Roman  province  of 
Gaul,  was  occupied  by  several  Teutonic 
tribes,  of  which  the  Franks  became  the 
most  powerful,  and  gave  their  name  to 
the  country.  The  kingdom  of  France, 
properly  speaking,  dates  from  the  accession 
of  Hugh  Capet  in  987  a.d. 

Passing  by  vague  traditions  concerning  the 
introduction  of  Christianity  into  Gaul  by  St. 
Paul,  or  St.  Luke,  Crescens  and  Trophimus, 
the  first  clearly  established  fact  is  the 
arrival  of  a  band  of  missionaries  from  Asia 
Minor  about  the  year  155  a.d.,  under  the 
leadership  of  Pothinus  and  Irenaius,  disciples 
of  Polycarp.  They  founded  the  sees  of  Lyons 
and  Vienne,  which  became  the  centres  of 
a  large  and  flourishing  Church  in  southern 
Gaul.  No  Church  suifered  more  severely 
from  the  persecution  which  was  directed 
against  Christianity  in  the  reign  of  M. 
Aurelius  Antoninus,  a.d.  177 ;  and  amongst 
the  martyrs  was  the  aged  bishop  of  Lyons, 
Pothinus.  He  was  succeeded  by  the  holy 
and  learned  Irenseus,  who  died  about  203 
A.D.  By  some  it  is  asserted  that  he  also 
suffered  martyrdom,  but  there  is  no  trust- 
worthy evidence  of  this. 

Towards  the  middle  of  the  third  century, 
another  missionary  band  was  despatched  to 
Gaul  by  Fabian,  bishop  of  Pome,  under 
the  direction  of  Dionysius  (St.  Denys),  (who 
was  confounded  in  popular  legends  with 
Dionysius  the  Areopagite),  Saturninus, 
Stremonius,  Martialis,  Trophimus,  Gatian, 
Paul.  They  founded  the  sees  of  Paris,  and 
Toulouse,  and  the  Church  in  Auvergne, 
Limoges,  Aries,  Tours,  and  Narbonne.  Most 
of  them  suffered  martyrdom  during  the 
persecution  in  the  reigns  of  Valerian  and 


CHURCH,  GALLICAN 


187 


Diocletian,  2G0-28C  a.d.  ;  but  the  Church 
continued  to  grow,  and  by  the  beginning  of 
the  fourth  century  it  was  firmly  established 
in  most  of  the  principal  cities  of  central 
and  southern  Gaul. 

The  most  illustrious  names  during  the 
fourth  century  are,  St.  Hilary,  bishop 
of  Poictiers — in  350  a.d.  one  of  the  most 
able  and  eloquent  champions  in  Western 
Christendom  of  the  orthodox  faith  against 
the  Arian  heresy;  and  St.  Martin,  bishop 
of  Tours  and  founder  of  the  celebrated 
Abbey  of  Marmoutiers  :  he  had  previously 
founded  the  Abbey  of  Ligugfi  near  Poictiers, 
which  was  the  first  monastery  planted  in 
Gaul.  Hardly  less  distinguished,  although 
more  short-lived  than  the  Abbey  of  Mar- 
moutiers, was  the  monastery  founded  early  in 
the  fifth  century  by  St.  Honoratus,  in  the 
isle  of  Lerins,  near  Frejus.  Honoratus 
became  bishop  of  Aries,  and  was  succeeded 
in  that  see  by  his  disciple  Hilary,  who  was 
almost  as  renowned  as  his  namesake  Hilary 
of  Poictiers.  In  the  same  monastery  were 
trained  Lupus,  who  accompanied  Germanus 
of  Auxerre,  into  Britain  to  suppress  the 
Pelagian  heresy,  and  afterwards  became 
bishop  of  Troyes ;  St.  Vincent,  the  author 
of  the  celebrated  definition  of  the  true 
Catholic  faith  as  that  which  was  held 
"  semper,  ubique,  et  ab  omnibus,"  (always, 
everywhere,  and  by  all);  and  Cassian,  the 
friend  of  St.  John  Chrysostom  and  the 
founder  of  the  Abbey  of  St.  Victor  at 
Marseilles.  The  Abbey  of  Lerins  was  de- 
stroyed by  the  Saracens  in  the  eighth  cen- 
tury, and  although  it  was  revived  it  never 
recovered  its  former  importance. 

During  the  decay  of  the  Poman  empire 
three  Teutonic  tribes  made  their  way  into 
Gaul,  and  gradually  occupied  nearly  the 
whole  of  it :  the  Visigoths  and  Burgundians, 
who  settled  in  the  south  and  south-eastern 
parts;  and  the  Franks,  who  entered  from 
the  north-east  and  pressed  southwards  until 
they  became  the  dominant  power.  The 
Teutonic  invaders  of  Gaul,  however,  did 
not,  like  the  Teutonic  invaders  of  Britain, 
drive  the  conquered  inhabitants  into  remote 
corners  of  the  country,  nor  attempt  to 
extirpate  their  religion.  They  had  been 
brought  more  into  contact  with  Roman 
civilization  and  Roman  law  than  the  con- 
querors of  Britain,  and  had  too  much  re- 
spect for  both  to  wish  to  sweep  them  away. 
The  Visigoths  and  Burgundians  had  em- 
braced Christianity,  though  under  the  form' 
of  Arianism,  before  they  entered  Gaul.  The 
Franks  remained  heathen  until  the  con- 
version of  their  king  Chlodwig  to  the 
Catholic  faith  in  496  a.d.  This  event 
greatly  assisted  him  in  subduing  the  other 
Teutonic  tribes  in  Gaul,  as  it  secured  for 
him  the  support  of  the   Church,   and  tha- 


188 


CHURCH,  GALLICAN 


sympathy  of  the  great  bulk  of  the  Gallo- 
Komau  population  which  had  adhered  to 
the  orthodox  creed.  Thus,  whereas  in 
Britain  the  religion  of  the  conquered  people 
was  rejected  and  despised  by  the  conquerors, 
and  helped  to  keep  the  two  races  apart,  in 
Gaul,  on  the  contrary,  the  religion  of  the 
conquered  being  adopted  by  their  con- 
querors, was  the  common  bond  which  drew 
them  more  and  more  together.  And  as  in 
Gaul  Roman  institutions  were  not  violently 
overthrown,  the  ecclesiastical  system  was 
carried  on  upon  the  same  principles  on 
which  it  had  been  framed  in  the  time  of  the 
Empire.  The  boundaries  of  the  several  dio- 
ceses followed  the  lines  of  civil  divisions :  each 
city  became  a  see,  and  the  chief  city  in  each 
province  became  the  seat  of  an  archbishop. 

The  Merovingian  dynasty  lasted  140 
yeare  from  the  death  of  Chlodwig  in  .511 
to  the  accession  of  Pippin  the  Short  in  752, 
during  which  period  there  was  a  very  close 
alliance  between  the  Church  and  the  Crown. 
But  it  cannot  be  said  that  the  character 
of  either  was  improved  by  the  connexion ; 
with  the  increase  of  wealth  the  discipline 
of  the  monasteries  became  relaxed,  the 
parish  priests  were  for  the  most  part  very 
ilhterate,  the  bishops  became  mixed  up  witb 
the  political  intrigues  that  continually  dis- 
tracted the  three  kingdoms  of  Austrasia, 
iTeustria,  and  Burgundy,  into  which  the 
kingdom  of  Chlodwig  after  his  death  was 
divided ;  and  they  seem  to  have  done  little 
or  nothing  to  purify  the  morals  of  the 
palace,  where  gross  licentiousness  prevailed, 
or  check  the  treachery  and  cruelty  with 
which  the  strifes  between  the  rival  kingdoms 
were  commonly  conducted. 

Charles  Martel  confiscated  a  large  amount 
of  Church  property  to  remunerate  the 
warriors  to  whose  devotion  and  courage  he 
was  indebted  for  his  splendid  victories. 
The  Church,  which  had  been  demoralised 
by  too  much  wealth,  became  completely 
disorganised  by  this  act  of  spoliation,  but 
it  was  reformed  in  some  measure  by 
the  sons  of  Charles,  Pippin,  and  Carloman, 
aided  by  the  illustrious  Englishman  Wini- 
frith,  better  known  as  St.  Boniface,  arch- 
bishop of  Mainz.  In  752  the  last  of  the 
Merovingians  was  formally  deposed,  and 
Pippin  having  been  proclaimed  king  of  the 
Franks  with  the  sanction  of  the  pope,  was 
<inointed  by  St.  Boniface. 

The  defeat  of  the  Saracens  in  Gaul  by 
Charles  Martel,  and  of  the  Lombards  in 
Italy  by  his  son  Pippin,  and  Pippin's  more 
illustrious  son  Charles,  earned  the  gratitude 
of  the  Church,  and  more  particularly  of  the 
Eoman  See.  The  coronation  of  Pippin  was 
renewed  by  Pope  Stephen  III.  with  his  own 
hands;  and  the  title  of  Patrician  of  Eome 
was  conferred  upon  him.     A  grander  title 


CHURCH,  GALLICAN 

and  more  substantial  power  was  bestowed 
upon  Charles,  when  the  pope  placed  the 
imperial  crown  upon  his  head  in  St.  Peter's 
at  Rome,  a.d.  800,  and  the  multitude 
saluted  him  as  "  Charles  Augustus,  crowned 
by  God,  the  great,  pious,  and  pacific  Em- 
peror of  the  Romans."  Gaul  formed  only 
a  part  of  the  vast  empire  of  Charles  the 
Great :  but  the  Church  there,  as  elsewhere, 
profited  by  his  vigorous  administration. 
His  capitularies  (see  Capitulary')  dealt  with 
ecclesiastical  afiairs  as  well  as  with  every 
department  of  life,  and  the  system  of  schools 
devised  and  organised  by  his  minister,  the 
celebrated  Englishman  Alcuin,  and  estab- 
lished in  all  the  cathedral  cities  and  the 
larger  monasteries,  made  the  Church  a  centre 
of  useful  and  religious  learning  and  educa- 
tion. 

Under  the  successors  of  Charles  the  Great, 
and  amidst  the  confusion  which  accom- 
panied the  break  up  of  his  empire,  the 
Church  again  deteriorated.  The  popes  saw 
their  opportunity  in  the  disorganisation  of 
the  Church  to  establish  their  own  claims 
to  interference.  They  asserted  an  absolute 
right  to  receive  appeals  in  all  ecclesiastical 
causes,  to  convoke  councils  at  their  pleasure, 
preside  over  them  in  person,  or  by  legates  a 
latere,  and  confirm  or  cancel  their  decisions. 
These  pretensions,  however,  were  firmly  re- 
sisted from  time  to  time,  and  by  none  more 
ably  than  Hincmar,  archbishop  of  Eheims, 
in  the  latter  half  of  the  ninth  century,  who 
may  be  regarded  as  the  first  great  champion 
of  the  constitutional  liberties  of  the  Gal- 
ilean Church.  And  although  Hincmar 
was  worsted  in  his  contest  with  the  astute 
and  ambitious  Pope  Nicolas  I.,  who  sup- 
ported the  Papal  claims  by  the  aid  of  the 
False  Decretals,  which  were  easily  accepted 
in  that  uncritical  age,  yet  the  principles  for 
which  Hincmar  strove  were  never  lost  sight 
of  by  the  Galilean  Church  ;  the  principles 
that  the  decrees  of  general  councils  were 
superior  to  the  authority  of  popes,  and 
that  provincial  councils  had  the  right  of 
deposing  bishops,  and  generally  dealing 
with  insubordinate  clerics  without  any  in- 
terference on  the  part  of  the  Papal  See. 

The  leading  characteristic  in  fact  of  the 
Galilean  Church  has  continually  been  the 
union  of  general  deference  to  the  Eoman 
See,  and  adherence  to  Roman  doctrine,  with 
a  considerable  amount  of  national  indepen- 
dence in  the  administration  of  the  Church. 
The  strife  concerning  investitures  which 
distracted  the  Church  at  large  during  the 
latter  part  of  the  eleventh  century  was  less 
violent  in  France  than  other  parts  of  Chris- 
tendom, and  was  equitably  settled  by  the 
admission  on  the  part  of  the  clergy  that  the 
sovereign  was  entitled  to  invest  prelates 
with  the  temporalities  of  their  ofiSce;   the 


CHURCH,  GaLLICAN 

Crown,  on  the  otlier  hand,  consenting  that 
the  oath  taken  should  be  that  of  "  hommage 
simple,"  not "  hommage  lige,"  and  should  be 
preceded  by  canonical  election  and  consecra- 
tion. 

The  interference  of  the  Crown  with  epi- 
scopal elections  was  resisted  in  Carolingian 
times  by  Hincmar  of  Eheims:  at  that 
period  the  right  of  election  was  asserted  to 
pertain  to  the  clergy  and  faithful  laity  of 
the  diocese;  towards  the  close  of  the 
twelfth  century  it  was  claimed  for  the 
cathedral  chapters  on  the  analogy  of  the 
election  of  the  pope  by  the  College  of 
Cardinals — a  practice  which  had  been  estab- 
lished in  1059  during  the  pontificate  of 
Nicolas  II.  This  right  of  the  chapters  to 
elect  was  formally  ratified  by  the  24th 
canon  of  the  great  Lateran  Council  in  1215. 
There  were  three  different  modes  of  pro- 
cedure in  electing — by  "inspiration,"  by 
"  compromise,"  or  by  "  scrutiny,"  borrowed 
from  the  usages  of  the  lioman  conclave; 
and  the  election  was  to  be  confirmed  by 
the  metropolitan,  with  an  appeal  in  case  of 
dispute  to  the  pope.  This  system,  which 
lasted  during  the  greater  part  of  three  cen- 
turies, did  not  work  well ;  the  Crown  was 
perpetually  pushing  its  own  favourites  into 
the  sees,  which  led  to  .'^imoniacal  contracts, 
and  appeals  to  Rome  became  so  frequent 
that  the  appointments  in  the  great  majority 
of  cases  were  directly  or  indirectly  made  by 
the  ]X)pe.  The  Pragmatic  Sanction  of  St. 
Louis  jiromiilgated  in  1268,  which  has  been 
styled  the  foundation  stone  of  the  Galilean 
liberties,  was  intended  to  be  a  remedy  for 
these  evils.  In  six  articles  it  (1)  declared 
that  all  patrons  of  benefices  should  freely 
enjoy  their  rights;  (2)  guaranteed  to  cathe- 
dral chapters  the  right  of  episcopal  election; 
(3)  directed  the  suppression  of  simony ;  (4) 
ordained  that  ecclesiastical  appointments 
should  be  made  conformably  to  the  common 
law,  the  canons  of  councils,  and  ancient 
institutions  of  the  Fathers ;  (5)  prohibited 
the  heavy  pecuniary  burdens  imposed  by 
the  Papal  Court  on  the  Church  of  France, 
and  provided  that  none  should  hereafter  be 
levied  except  for  reasonable,  pious,  and 
urgent  causes,  with  the  free  consent  of  the 
king  and  the  Church ;  (6)  confirmed  all 
franchises  and  privileges  granted  by  the 
king  and  his  predecessors  to  the  several 
ecclesiastical  bodies  in  his  realm. 

The  Pragmatic  Sanction,  however,  of  St. 
Louis  had  little  permanent  effect  in  check- 
ing simoniacal  corruption,  or  Papal  inter- 
ference with  election.  The  Church  was 
more  successful  in  maintaining  the  inde- 
pendence of  her  provincial  councils.  From 
the  time  of  Nicolas  I.  the  popes  had 
asserted'  on  the  strength  of  the  Pseudo 
Decretals    that   no    council   was  legitmate 


CHURCH,  GALLIGAN 


18? 


unless  sanctioned  by  the  Holy  See ;  and  by 
the  extraordinary  poweis  with  which  their 
legates  a  latere  were  invested  they  en- 
deavoured to  obtain  absolute  control  over 
the  action  of  local  councils.  These  pre- 
tensions were  firmly  resisted  in  France, 
especially  by  the  canonists  Gerbert  and  Ivo 
of  Chartres,  and  the  legatine  authority  was 
gradually  restricted,  until  it  became  com- 
paratively hannless,  and  after  the  middle 
of  the  fourteenth  century  Papal  legates 
rarely  presided  in  Galilean  councils. 

Near  the  close  of  the  fourteenth  century 
there  was  a  long  and  obstinate  contest 
between  the  King  Philip  IV.  (the  Fair) 
and  the  Pope  Boniface  VIII.  The  dispute 
originated  in  the  imposition  of  a  certain  tax 
on  the  clergy  by  the  Crown  without  the 
Papal  consent,  and  in  the  creation  of  an 
episcopal  see  and  the  appointment  to  it  by 
the  pope  on  his  own  sole  authority.  The 
struggle,  which  was  carried  on  with  great 
pertinacity  and  warmth  on  both  sides,  re- 
sulted in  a  victory  for  Philip ;  but  from 
this  epoch  must  be  dated  the  tendency  of 
the  Church  in  France  to  fall  more  and 
more  into  a  state  of  subjection  to  the 
Crown. 

This  subjection  was  also  effected  by  the 
steady  aggression  during  the  fourteenth  and 
fifteenth  centuries  of  the  civil  power  on  the 
authority  of  the  spiritual  courts.  The 
clergy  were  brought  more  and  more  within 
the  range  of  secular  jurisdiction — a  great 
variety  of  causes  touching  all  departments 
of  life  were  gradually  transferred  from  the 
ecclesiastical  to  the  civil  courts ;  and  the 
appeal  to  the  Crown  called  "appel  comme 
d'abus,"  which  was  originally  intended  (as 
the  name  implies)  only  to  check  the  abuses 
of  spiritual  jurisdiction,  was  more  and  more 
resorted  to  on  various  pretexts  in  matters 
small  as  well  as  great,  until  it  completely 
crippled  even  the  legitimate  action  of  the 
ecclesiastical  courts. 

During  the  residence  of  the  popes  in 
Avignon,  for  seventy  years,  1309-1376,  they 
were  practically  vassals  of  the  French  kings, 
who  readily  connived  at  their  Iniquities  in 
order  to  obtain  pontifical  sanction  for  their 
own  encroachments  on  the  liberties  of  tha 
national  Church. 

The  Church  of.  France,  however,  may 
claim  the  merit  of  making  the  first  effectual 
effort  to  heal  the  schism  in  the  Papal  suc- 
cession, which  distracted  the  Western 
Church  (1378-1429)  by  means  of  a  general 
council,  and  the  master  spirit  of  the  Council 
of  Constance  (1414  a.d.),  which  deposed 
Pope  John  XXIII,  was  Jean  Gerson,  Chan- 
cellor of  the  University  of  Paris,  who  ably 
maintained  the  authority  of  a  general 
council  to  be  superior  to  that  of  the  pope. 
The    same    doctrine   was    upheld  by    the 


190 


CHUECH,  GALLICAN 


Council  of  Basle,  1431,  which  deposed,  a.d. 
1439,  the  Poi^e  Eugenius  IV.,  and  the  decrees 
of  Basle  were  accepted  with  some  modifica- 
tions by  the  French  Church  in  a  National 
Council  held  at  Bourges,  1438.  This 
council,  however,  did  not  acquiesce  in  the 
•deposition  of  the  pope. 

The  same  council  drew  up  the  decrees 
which  constitute  the  Pragmatic  Sanction  of 
Bourges.  They  were  expressed  in  23  articles, 
of  which  the  most  imjwrtant  were  those 
which  declared  the  authority  of  general 
councils,  enjoined  ecclesiastical  elections  to 
be  made  in  accordance  with  the  canons,  by 
cathedral,  collegiate,  and  conventual  chapters, 
secured  the  rights  of  patrons  to  benefices, 
■only  reserving  a  veto  for  the  pope  in  the 
event  of  unfitness  or  uncanonical  election, 
and  the  nomination  to  benefices  of  which 
the  incumbents  happened  to  die  at  Rome, 
abolished  the  practice  of  "  reserves,"  "  an- 
nates," and  "expective  graces,"  and  regu- 
lated the  order  of  ecclesiastical  appeals, 
which  were  in  no  case  to  be  carried  to  the 
pope  until  the  suit  had  passed  through  the 
jntei-mediato  tribunals.  The  Pragmatic 
Sanction  was  registered  by  the  Parliament 
•of  Paris  in  July,  143!i,  and  so  became  part 
of  the  statute  law  of  France.  Its  publica- 
tion caused  great  satisfaction  throughout 
the  kingdom,  and  great  indignation  at  Rome, 
where  it  was  vehemently  denounced  by  one 
pope  after  another.  Louis  XL  was  induced 
fcy  mingled  threats,  flatteries,  and  entreaties 
from  Rome,  to  revoke  it  soon  after  his 
•accession  in  1461.  He  also  hoped  to  obtain 
more  power  of  interference  with  the  capitular 
rights  of  election,  and  with  private  patron- 
age, an  expectation  in  which  he  found  him- 
self thwarted  by  Papal  artifices.  The 
Pragmatic  Sanction  was  never  formally  re- 
pealed by  the  parliament,  and  Louis  XII. 
le-established  it  by  royal  edict,  which  in- 
volved him  in  strife  with  Pope  Julius  II., 
A.D.  1509.  The  death  of  Julius  in  1513, 
and  of  Louis  in  1515,  followed  by  the 
accession  of  Leo  X.  to  the  Papal  chair,  and 
of  Francis  I.  to  the  French  throne,  rendered 
the  prospect  of  a  settlement  more  hopeful. 
This  was  effected  by  the  Concordat  of 
Bologna,  151^,  which  sacrificed  many  of  the 
liberties  secured  by  the  Pragmatic  Sanction 
either  to  the  king  or  the  pope.  The  right 
of  nomination  to  bishoprics  was  transferred 
from  the  capitular  bodies  to  the  Crown,  and 
the  Papal  claim  to  annates  was  tacitly 
allowed.  Thus  it  has  been  well  remarked, 
"the  pope  surrendered  to  the  king  a 
spiritual  privilege,  and  obtained  in  return 
a  purely  secular  advantage."  No  mention 
was  made  of  the  decrees  of  Constance,  Basle, 
and  Bourges,  which  established  the  superi- 
ority of  councils  over  the  pope.  The 
•Parliament  of  Paris,  after  resisting  to  the 


CHUECH,  GALLICAN 

verge  of  an  open  rupture  with  the  king, 
coijsented,  under  protest,  to  register  the 
Concordat ;  and  the  Pragmatic  Sanction  was 
abrogated  by  Lateran  Council,  Dec.  19, 
1516 ;  but  the  Concordat  was  very  ir- 
regularly and  grudgingly  obeyed  by  the 
clergy,  and  the  Gallican  Church  never  lost 
an  opportunity  of  protesting  against  it. 

Such  was  the  condition  of  the  Church  in 
France  on  the  eve  of  the  reforming  move- 
ment. It  must  be  borne  in  mind  that  all 
this  time,  whilst  contending  for  freedom  of 
administration,  the  Gallican  Church  re- 
mained steadfastly  obedient  to  the  Roman 
See  in  all  other  respects.  No  Church  had 
responded  with  more  enthusiasm  to  the 
repeated  calls  to  the  Crusades ;  no  Church 
had  produced  a  more  fervent  and  powerful 
champion  of  the  faith  than  was  exhibited  in 
the  person  of  St.  Bernard  ;  no  Church  had 
suppressed  heresy  with  more  relentless 
rigour;  no  Church  fell  more  \mder  the 
influence  of  the  Franciscans  and  Dominicans 
in  the  thirteenth  century,  or  of  the  Jesuits 
in  the  sixteenth  and  seventeenth. 

During  the  reforming  movement  the 
same  combination  of  a  spirit  of  national 
independence,  with  adherence  to  Roman 
doctrine,  is  observable  in  the  French  Church 
as  in  earlier  times.  The  conference  held 
at  Poissy  in  1560,  with  a  view  of  reconciling 
the  diflerences  between  Catholics  and  Protes- 
tants, was  a  total  failure.  On  the  other 
hand,  although  the  articles  of  faith  drawn 
up  by  the  Council  of  TVent  were  accepted, 
the  canons  relating  to  Church  government 
were  repudiated  by  the  Parliament  of  Paris 
as  infringing  upon  national  liberties.  The 
adoption  of  the  articles  of  Trent  as  an 
authoritative  definition  of  doctrine  was  an 
almost  insurmountable  barrier  to  reconcili- 
ation between  the  Church  of  France  and  the 
Protestants,  and  the  hope  was  finally  ex- 
tinguished by  the  cruel  massacre  of  the 
Huguenots  on  St.  Bartholomew's  Day,  1572, 
and  the  conversion  to  the  Roman  Catholic 
faith  of  Henry  of  Navarre  after  his  accession 
to  the  throne.  Henry,  indeed,  secured  free 
religious  toleration  for  the  Huguenots  by  the 
Treaty  of  Nantes,  1598.  On  the  other  hand, 
he  recalled  the  Jesuits  who  had  been 
banished  from  the  kingdom  after  the 
assassination  of  Henry  III.,  being  accused  of 
teaching  that  princes  deposed  by  the  pope 
lost  their  claim  to  the  allegiance  of  their 
subjects.  Henry  IV.  also  required  a  Jesuit 
preacher  to  reside  at  Court  to  be  answerable 
for  the  good  conduct  of  his  order,  the  result 
of  which  was  that  he  himself  fell  under  the 
influence  of  the  preacher  selected,  who 
became  his  confessor,  and  that  a  series  of 
Jesuit  confessors  directed  the  consciences  of 
his  successors — Louis  XIII.,  XIV.,  and  XV. 
When  the  States-General  met  in  1614,  the 


CHUECH,  GALLICAN 

"Tiers  iStat  declared  in  their  report  that  no 
jower  on  earth  has  a  right  to  depose 
■sovereigns.  This  declaration  was  provoked 
by  a  treatise  written  by  the  Jesuit  Suarez 
against  James  I.  of  England ;  and  from  this 
time  the  Jesuit  influence  at  Court  was 
exerted  to  prevent  the  reassembling  of  the 
.iStates-General,  a  policy  in  which  they 
succeeded  only  too  well,  for  the  States  did 
not  meet  again  till  1789,  the  eve  of  the 
Kevolution  which  swept  both  Church  and 
Throne  away.  The  persecution  of  the 
.Jansenists  (see  Jansenists)  in  the  seven- 
teenth century  was  mainly  conducted  by  the 
■Jesuits.  Their  cold  and  rigid  dogmatism 
in  theology,  and  their  system  of  casuistry 
in  morals,  would  have  been  fatally  injurious 
to  the  Church,  if  their  influence  had  not 
been  counteracted  in  some  measure  by  the 
saintliness  of  such  men  as  St.  Francis  de 
Sales,  St.  Vincent  de  Paul,  and  F&elon,  and 
the  wide  learning  and  large-mindedness  of 
isuch  men  as  Pascal  and  Bossuet. 

The  orthodoxy  of  the  Galilean  Church 
from  the  Roman  point  of  view  remained 
unassailable  during  the  long  period  of  its 
■subjection  to  the  Crown,  ruled  by  Jesuit 
influence.  But  Louis  XIV.  was  as  tenacious 
of  his  rights  over  the  Church,  as  jealous  of 
Papal  interference,  as  any  of  his  predecessors. 
He  was  involved  in  a  long  strife  with  Pope 
Innocent  XL  respecting  the  rights  of  the 
Orown  over  vacant  sees,  which  ended  in  the 
promulgation  by  the  king  in  1682  of  the 
•celebrated  four  articles,  (i.)  That  the  ecclesi- 
.astical  power  has  no  right  over  the  tempo- 
ralities of  the  kingdom  (ii.)  That  a  general 
council  is  superior  to  the  pope,  (iii.)  That 
the  exercise  of  the  Papal  power  should  be 
controlled  by  canons  and  local  customs, 
(iv.)  That  the  judgment  of  the  pope  is  not 
infallible  except  when  conflrmed  by  the 
Church.  The  persecution  of  the  Protestants, 
and  the  revocation  of  the  Edict  of  Nantes, 
1685,  deprived  Prance  of  a  large  number  of 
the  most  intelligent  and  industrious  in- 
habitants. The  Church  however  generally 
approved  of  this  harsh  and  unwise  measure, 
and  from  this  time  forward  the  close 
alliance  between  the  clergy  and  a  despotic 
monarchy,  the  repressive  line  adopted  by 
both  towards  all  freedom  of  scientiflc  and 
relifdous  thought,  the  luxurious  and  secular 
fityle  of  life  prevalent  in  the  upper  ranks  of 
the  hierarchy,  and  their  close  connexion 
■vrith  a  highly-privileged  and  wealthy  aristo- 
cracy, estranged  the  Church  from  the  love 
and  respect  of  the  people,  and  rendered  it 
quite  incapable  of  stemming  the  advancing 
tide  of  atheistic  philosophy  and  political 
discontent.  At  last  the  crash  came.  In 
1789  the  States-General  abolished  tithes, 
confiscated  the  landed  property  of  the 
Church,  and  dissolved  the  monasteries.    In 


CHUECH,  GALLICAN 


191 


1790  it  framed  the  "  Civil  Constitution  of 
the  Clergy,"  which  was,  in  fact,  a  reoonsti- 
tution  of  the  Church.  It  suppressed  135 
bishoprics,  and  erected  83  in  their  stead,  to 
correspond  in  number  and  extent  with  the 
civil  division  of  the  country  into  depart- 
ments. Bishops  and  clergy  were  to  be 
elected  by  the  people,  and  confirmed  by  thu 
metropolitan ;  the  pope  was  to  be  informed 
of  the  appointments,  but  no  application  to 
be  made  for  his  consent.  All  the  clergy 
were  required  to  take  an  oath  of  fidelity  to 
the  constitution.  This  caused  a  schism,  for 
many  of  the  clergy  refused  to  take  the  oath ; 
but  jurors  and  non-jurors  were  soon  alike 
overwhelmed  in  the  storm  of  political  and 
religious  anarchy  which  swept  over  France. 
For  ten  years  all  national  recognition  of 
Christianity  was  suppressed,  all  forms  of 
Christian  worship  proscribed. 

When  Napoleon  Buonaparte  became  First 
Consul  in  a.d.  1800,  the  storm  had  spent 
itself,  and  the  public  mind  had  become 
wearied  and  disgusted  by  the  horrors  of  the 
Eeign  of  Terror.  Buonaparte's  own  religious 
belief  seems  to  have  been  of  the  vaguest 
description,  but  from  political  considerations 
he  determined  to  restore  the  public  pro- 
fesision  of  Christianity.  For  this  purpose 
he  entered  into  negotiations  with  Pope 
Pius  VII.,  which  resulted  in  the  celebrated 
Concordat  of  1801,  of  which  the  following 
were  the  principal  provisions:  (i.)  The 
Boman  Catholic  religion  was  declared  to  be 
that  of  the  French  government,  and  of  the 
majority  of  Frenchmen ;  its  worship  was  to 
be  publicly  celebrated  throughout  France, 
(ii.)  The  ancient  sees — 159  in  number — were 
suppressed  by  the  pope,  and  60  new  ones 
were  created  in  their  stead,  to  which  the 
First  Consul  was  to  nominate  and  the  pope  to 
institute,  (iii.)  The  bishops  were  to  collate 
to  the  parochial  cures,  their  choice  being 
subject  to  the  approval  of  the  government. 
(iv.)  The  Pope  sanctioned  the  sale  of  Church 
property  which  had  taken  place  during  the 
Revolution ;  and  the  French  government,  in 
return,  pledged  itself  to  make  an  adequate 
provision  for  the  maintenance  of  the  clergy 
of  all  ranks,  (v.)  All  clerics  were  to  take  an 
oath  of  allegiance  to  the  existing  govern- 
ment. Several  articles  called  the  "  Organic 
Decrees,"  artfully  appended  to  the  Con- 
cordat, and  regulating  the  details  of  ad- 
ministration and  public  worship,  rendered 
the  Church  more  entirely  dependent  on  the 
State  than  it  had  ever  been.  The  pope  and 
the  clergy  remonstrated  against  them,  but 
in  vain.  In  some  respects  the  Concordat 
had  been  efiected  by  the  exercise  of  a 
despotic  power  on  the  part  of  the  pope,  but 
Buonaparte  took  care  that  his  own  authority 
should  be  paramount.  At  his  coronation  in 
Paris  the  pope  anointed  him,  but  he  islaced 


192 


CHUECH,  GEEEK 


the  crown  on  his  head  with  his  ovm  hands. 
The  re-establishment  of  the  Church  was 
only  to  impart  a  kind  of  dignity  and  sanctity 
to  his  usurpation  of  the  throne,  and  to  assist 
in  imposing  the  fiction  on  the  world  that  he 
•was  a  modem  reproduction  of  Charles  the 
Great,  and  the  representative  of  the  ancient 
line  of  Koman  emperors. 

After  the  fall  of  Buonaparte  and  the 
restoration  of  the  Bourbon  moharchy,  the 
vigour  and  activity  of  the  Church  revived. 
The  Jesuits,  who  had  been  banished  in 
1764,  returned;  and,  unfortunately,  their 
influence,  in  alliance  with  an  Ultramontane 
party,  prevented  any  return  to  true  Gallioan 
jjrinciples.  Ultramontanism  was  supreme 
during  the  reign  of  Charles  X.  In  the  latter 
part  of  the  reign  of  Louis  Philippe  there  was 
a  remarkable  development  of  spiritual  and 
intellectual  life  in  the  Church,  of  which  the 
most  distinguished  leaders  were  Lacordaire, 
Montalembert,  and  Lamennais.  The  latter 
endeavoured  to  combine  Ultramontane  views 
with  advanced  demooi'atical  principles,  but 
he  ultimately  lapsed  into  infidelity.  Mont- 
alembert remained  to  the  last  a  Liberal  in 
ix)litics,  and  a  loyal  son  of  the  Church ;  but 
he  died  out  of  favour  with  the  Pope  Pius  IX., 
because  he  protested  against  the  dogma  of 
Papal  infallibility.  Since  the  promulgation 
of  this  dogma,  the  breach  between  the 
Liberal  party  and  the  Church  in  Prance,  as 
in  other  Roman  Catholic  countries,  has 
gro^vn  continually  wider,  and  under  the 
present  Republic,  the  hope  of  reconciliation 
seems  more  distant  than  ever.  No  doubt, 
in  spite  of  much  infidelity  and  indifference, 
a  large  proportion  of  the  French  people  are 
still  attached  to  the  Church,  and  most  of 
the  clergy  are  irreproachable  in  conduct; 
some  of  them  able,  learned,  and  eloquent ; 
but  they  are  oppressed  with  poverty,  the 
State  is  more  inclined  to  reduce .  than  to 
increase  their  scanty  emoluments,  and 
much  spiritual  destitution,  especially  in  the 
rural  districts!,  is  the  inevitable  result.  The 
expulsion  of  the  monastic  orders  and  other 
tyrannical  acts  are  highly  discreditable  to  a 
Hepublican  government  in  an  age  of  religious 
toleration. — Histoire  de  I'Eglise  de  France, 
by  the  Abbe  Guettee ;  Histoire  de  VEglise 
Gallicane,  Jacques  Longueval  and  his  Suc- 
cessors ;  History  of  the  Church  of  France, 
by  Reverend  W.  H.  Jervis;  The  Student's 
History  of  France,  by  the  same ;  Tlie  Gal- 
ilean Churcli,  by  Reverend  Julius  Lloyd, 
B.P.C.K.    [W.  R.  W.  S.] 

CHURCH,  THE  GREEK  CATHOLIC, 
OR  EASTERN  ORTHODOX.  The  desig- 
nation Greek  Church  or  Eastern  Church,  if 
used  in  reference  to  the  first  six  centuries  of 
the  Christian  era,  is  only  a  geographical  ex- 
pression to  denote  the  Church  in  the  eastern 
portions  of  the  Roman  Empire  where  Greek 


CHUECH,  GEEEK 

was  generally  spoken.  The  Church  through- 
out Christendom  was  substantially  one  in 
doctrine  and  modes  of  worship.  But  after 
the  removal  of  the  seat  of  empire  from 
Rome  to  Byzantium  there  was  a  continually- 
increasing  tendency  to  disruption,  and  a 
division  of  the  Church  into  two  distinct 
branches,  with  Rome  and  Constantinople  as- 
the  two  separate  heads.  The  process  of 
separation,  however,  was  slow  and  gradual,, 
and  the  causes  were  mixed,  being  partly 
political,  partly  theological,  and  partly  de- 
rived from  those  differences  in  temperament 
and  habits  of  thought  which  distinguish 
Oriental  from  Western  races. 

All  that  can  be  attempted  in  the  compass 
of  this  article  is  briefiy  to  indicate  the  prin- 
cipal outward  events  which  led  on  step  by 
step  to  a  complete  and  final  rupture  between 
the  Eastern  and  Western  branches  of  the 
Church. 

One  of  the  first  symptoms  of  serious  rivalry 
between  the  occupants  of  the  Roman  and 
Byzantine  sees  was  in  a.d.  694,  when 
Gregory  the  Great  objected  to  the  assump^ 
tion  of  the  title  "oecumenical  Bishop" 
(which  he  also  disclaimed  for  himself)  by  the 
patriarch  of  Constantinople.  The  adoption, 
of  the  title,  however,  was  sanctioned  by  the 
6  th  and  7  th  General  Councils,  and  has  been 
retained  by  the  patriarchs  to  the  present 
day. 

The  first  grave  discord  between  East  and 
West  on  theological  grounds  was  the  Mono- 
thelite  controversy  (see  Monothelites')  which 
was  carried  on  with  great  acrimony.  Mono- 
thelism  was  condemned  at  Rome  by  a  coun- 
cil (a.d.  649),  called  the  1st  Lateran  Council, 
a  few  years  after  which  (653)  the  Pope 
Martiu  I.  and  Maximus,  a  monk  who  had 
been  the  ablest  opponent  of  Monothelism, 
were  violently  carried  to  Constantinople  and 
treated  with  barbarous  cruelty.  The  Em- 
peror Constantino  IV.  (Pogonatus)  endea- 
voured to  heal  the  controversy  by  a  general 
council  (the  6th,  called  in  Trullo),  a.d.  680, 
which  condemned  Monothelism  and  its 
adherents,  including  a  former  pope,  Honorius 
I.,  who  had  been  favourable  to  Monothelistic 
opinions.  The  decrees  of  the  council  were 
signed  by  the  representatives  of  East  and 
West.  But  five  years  later  (685)  a  kind  of 
supplementary  synod,  also  held  at  Constan- 
tinople, enacted  some  disciplinary  canons 
which  were  directly  contrary  to  Roman 
usages;  by  the  13th,  e.g.  clergy  married 
before  their  ordination  as  subdeacons  were 
permitted  to  retain  their  wives ;  by  the 
55th  fasting  on  any  Saturday  except  Easter- 
eve  was  forbidden,  whereas  at  Rome  it  was 
the  custom  to  observe  all  Saturdays  in  Lent 
as  fast  days.  The  Pope  Sergius  I.  declared 
that  he  would  rather  die  than  subscribe  to 
these  canons,  and  in  this  resolution  he  was 


CHTJECH,  GEEEK 

supported  by  the  Koman  populace,  wliO 
rescued  Mm  from  an  imperial  ofiScer  who 
had  been  sent  to  seize  him. 

The  next  great  cause  of  dissension  was 
the  Iconoclastic  controversy.  The  severe 
edicts  issued  by  the  Emperor  Leo  the  Isaurian 
A.D.  724  against  the  veneration  of  sacred 
images  were  strongly  resented  by  the  West- 
ern Church.  Pope  Gregory  11.,  however, 
although  he  rejected  the  edicts  did  not  take 
any  strong  measures  of  opposition.  His 
successor,  Gregory  III.,  held  a  council  a.d. 
731  attended  by  98  Isi  shops,  which  con- 
demned iconoclasm  and  iconoclasts,  although 
the  emperor  was  not  mentioned  by  name. 
He  retaliated  by  confiscating  the  Papal 
revenues  in  Sicily  and  Calabria,  and  trans- 
ferring Greece  and  Illyricum  from  the 
Roman  to  the  Byzantine  patriarchate.  Con- 
stantino V.  (Copronymus)  held  a  council  in 
754  which  condemned  the  use  of  images. 
It  was  attended  only  by  those  bishops  who 
were  completely  subservient  to  the  court 
influence,  and  the  summons  was  disregarded 
by  Pope  Stephen  altogether. 

Leo  IV.  (a.d.  775),  the  son  of  Constantine, 
was  more  tolerant  of  the  veneration  of 
images,  and  his  wife  Irene,  who  was  posi- 
tively favourable  to  the  practice,  issued  an 
edict  of  toleration  after  his  death.  A  general 
council  summoned  in  786  met  first  at  Con- 
stantinople, and  afterwards  adjourned  to 
Nicsea.  The  pope  was  represented  by  two 
envoys.  The  council  sanctioned  the  vene- 
ration of  images  (Ttpo<TKvirq<ns)  but  forbade 
such  service  (Xarpem)  being  paid  to  them 
as  belonged  to  the  Divine  nature  only.  And 
it  is  to  be  noted  that  the  images  sanctioned 
by  this  council  were  not  to  be  works  of 
sculpture,  but  only  paintings  or  mosaics; 
and  to  this  limitation  the  Eastern  Church 
has  ever  since  adhered. 

The  decisions  of  this  council  were  accepted 
at  Home,  but  rejected  by  a  synod  of  the 
Frankish  clergy  held  at  Frankfort  in  794 
imder  Charles  the  Great.  The  friendly 
relations,  however,  between  the  Papacy  and 
Charles  were  not  disturbed  by  this  division 
of  opinion.  The  tie  of  pohtical  interest  in 
fact  between  the  Pope  and  the  great 
sovereign  of  the  West  was  far  stronger  now 
than  any  tie,  political  or  religious,  between 
the  Papacy  and  the  Eastern  Empire.  The 
power  of  Eastern  rule  was  still  felt  in  Italy 
in  the  vexatious  form  of  taxation;  it  was 
not  felt  in  the  only  way  which  would 
have  been  acceptable:  the  supply  of  help 
against  Lombard  invasion.  These  causes  of 
political  discontent  added  to  jealousy  of 
the  pretensions  of  the  Byzantine  See,  the 
removal  of  Greece  and  Illyricum  from  the 
Eoman  jurisdiction,  and  the  recollection  of 
past  theological  differences,  all  tended  to 
loosen  the  bond  of  union  between  the  two 


CHUKCH,  GKEEK  193 

Churches.  Such  was  the  condition  of  things 
towards  the  close  of  the  eighth  century. 

The  controversy  concerning  the  Double 
Procession  of  the  Holy  Spirit  (see  Procession) 
and  the  insertion  of  the  Filioque  clause  in 
the  Kicene  Creed,  which  was  destined  to  be 
the  most  fatal  cause  of  schism,  began  early 
in  the  ninth  century.  It  seemed  to  be  laid 
to  rest  before  the  end  of  Charles  the  Great's 
reign,  but  it  smouldered  on  under  the  surface, 
as  it  were,  only  to  break  forth  at  last  with 
uncontrollable  fury. 

In  859  the  intervention  of  the  pope  was 
solicited  to  help  in  settling  a  disputed 
election  to  the  See  of  Constantinople,  but 
the  haughty  dictatorial  tone  assumed  by 
Nicolas  I.  only  provoked  resentment,  and 
led  to  an  angry  correspondence  between  him 
and  the  Emperor  Michael  III.  Nicolas  also 
excited  much  indignation  at  Constantinople 
by  interfering  with  ecclesiastical  affairs  in 
Bulgaria  which  had  been  originally  converted 
to  Christianity  by  Byzantine  missionaries. 
The  patriarch  issued  a  circular  letter  de- 
nouncing the  intrusion  of  the  pope  and 
accusing  the  Eoman  Church  of  irregular 
practices,  and  heretical  opinions  especially 
in  regard  to  the  Procession  of  the  Holy 
Ghost.  A  council  held  at  Constantinople  in 
869  decided  that  Bulgaria  belonged  to  the 
Byzantine  See,  and  all  the  Latin  clergy 
were  expelled  from  that  country.  The 
quarrel  about  the  election  to  the  patri- 
archate, and  the  respective  rights  of  Eome 
and  Constantinople  over  Bulgaria,  lingered 
for  several  years  longer.  Friendly  relations 
were  re-established  in  a.d.  900,  but  the 
reconciliation  was  not  cordial,  and  during 
the  tenth  century  (a  very  dark  period  in 
the  annals  of  the  Papacy)  there  was  but 
little  intercourse  between  the  two  Churches. 

In  the  following  century  the  increasing 
power  of  the  Papacy,  and  the  advance  of 
the  Normans  in  Southern  Italy,  which 
threatened  to  deprive  the  Eastern  Empire 
of  its  Itahan  possessions,  were  soirrces  of 
grave  anxiety  to  the  emperor  and  the 
patriarch.  In  1024  they  made  a  proposal 
to  John  XVIII.  that  the  title  of  "  oecumeni- 
cal "  should  be  equally  enjoyed  by  the 
bishops  of  Constantinople  and  Eome.  The 
suggestion  was  accompanied  by  handsome 
offerings  which  induced  the  pope  to  Usten 
to  it,  but  the  negotiation  ultimately  came 
to  nought. 

In  1053  the  patriarch  of  Constantinople, 
Michael  Cerularius,  and  Leo,  the  metro- 
politan of  Bulgaria,  addressed  a  letter  to  the 
bishop  of  Trani,  in  Apulia,  warning  him  of 
the  errors  of  the  Eoman  Church,  which  were 
ranged  under  four  principal  heads,  (i.)  the 
use  of  unleavened  bread  in  the  Eucharist ; 
(ii.)  the  practice  of  fasting  on  Saturdays  in 
Lent ;  (iii.)  the  eating  of  things  strangled ; 

0 


194 


CHURCH,  GEEEK 


(iv.)  the  singing  of  the  great  Hallelujah  at 
Easter  only.  Thiee  envoys  were  despatched 
by  the  Pope  Leo  IX.  to  Constantinople  to 
discuss  these  questions,  and  were  favourably 
received  by  the  emperor,  but  the  patriarch 
refused  to  treat  with  them,  and  they  in  their 
turn  anathematized  the  patriarch. 

It  might  have  been  expected  that  the 
Crusades  would  have  drawn  Eastern  and 
Western  Christendom  together  in  the  bands 
of  a  common  enterprise  against  the  infidel : 
but  the  contempt  with  which  the  crusaders 
treated  the  Greek  Christians  in  Palestine 
and  elsewhere,  the  cruelty  and  profanity  of 
the  crusading  army  which  captured  Con- 
stantinople in  1204,  and  the  elevation  of  an 
Italian,  Morosini,  to  the  patriarchal  throne 
embittered  the  relations  between  the  two 
Churches  beyond  hope  of  remedy. 

A  serious  effort  however  to  effect  a 
reconciliation  was  made  by  Pope  Gregory  X. 
and  the  Emperor  Michael  PaliEologus  in 
1274.  It  was  indeed  the  interest  of  each  to 
bs  on  friendly  terms  with  the  other.  The 
pope  wanted  assistance  for  a  crusade,  and  the 
emperor  needed  protection  against  the  designs 
of  Charles  of  Anjou,  king  of  Sicily.  A  great 
council  was  convened  at  Lyons  at  which  the 
patriarchs  of  Constantinople  and  Antloch 
were  present,  more  than  500  bishops  and 
upwards  of  1000  smaller  dignitaries.  The 
Greek  ambassadors  were  received  with  great 
honour ;  and  the  representatives  of  the 
Greek  Church  generally  were  in  the  most 
submissive  mood.  They  admitted  the  prim- 
acy of  the  Eoman  See ;  they  even  chanted 
the  Nicene  Creed  with  the  "  Filioque " 
clause.  At  the  fourth  session  of  the 
council  the  reconciliation  of  the  Churches 
was  formally  ratified.  But  animosities  of 
long  standing  cannot  be  healed  by  the 
decrees  of  a  council,  and  the  cruelty  with 
which  the  emperor  tried  to  force  the  terms 
of  the  union  upon  his  subjects  only  increased 
the  irritation,  and  rendered  the  discord 
between  the  Churches  after  his  death  more 
hopeless  than  ever. 

During  the  fourteenth  century  and  the 
beginning  of  the  fifteenth,  the  pressure  of 
the  Mohammedan  power  on  the  Eastern 
Empire  made  the  emperors  look  once  more 
to  Western  Christendom  for  help  :  and  they 
supported  their  appeals  by  professing  a 
desire  for  the  reconciliation  of  the  Churches : 
but  the  majority  of  the  Eastern  Christians 
held  the  Latins  in  abomination,  and  neither 
the  overtures  of  the  Emperor  Andronicus 
III.  (a.d.  1330-1341)  nor  the  submission  of 
his  son  John  Palffiologus  (a.d.  1369),  who 
acknowledged  the  Eoman  supremacy  and 
the  "  double  procession,"  and  did  homage  to 
the  pope  in  St.  Peter's,  had  any  lasting 
beneficial  effect. 

AVhen  the  Council  of  Basel  met,  a.d.  1431, 


CHUECH,  GEEEK 

the  Greeks  were  invited  by  the  council  and 
the  pope  to  a  conference  upon  the  points  in 
dispute  between  the  two  Churches.  But 
the  pope  and  the  coxmcil  could  not  agree 
upon  the  place  of  meeting.  At  length  the 
pope  (Eugenius  IV.)  and  his  party,  although 
in  a  minority,  fixed  on  Perrara  and  opened 
a  council  there,  January  8,  1438.  The 
Greek  emperor  and  patriarch,  and  their 
followers,  more  than  500  in  all,  were  con- 
veyed to  Italy  in  Venetian  ships  and  reached 
Ferrara  on  March  12.  After  some  vexa- 
tious disputes  at  the  outset  about  questions 
of  ceremony  and  precedence  twelve  champions 
were  selected  from  either  side  to  discuss  the 
theological  questions.  These  were  ranged 
under  four  principal  heads :  (i.)  Double  Pro- 
cession; (ii.)  Purgatory;  (iii.)  Unleavened 
bread;  (iv.)  the  Papal  Supremacy.  The 
formal  discussion  did  not  begin  till  October 
1438.  In  February  1439  the  council  was 
transfered  to  Florence,  and  held  its  last 
session  there  on  March  24.  Some  articles 
of  union  were  drawn  up  in  a  spirit  of  com- 
promise upon  the  disputed  points,  and 
subscribed  by  the  representatives  of  the  two 
Churches  ;  but  they  proved  as  ineffectual  as 
all  former  devices  for  healing  the  schism ; 
and  a  few  years  later,  1443,  the  Council  of 
Florence  was  denounced  by  the  patriarchs 
of  Alexandria,  Antloch,  and  Jerusalem,  and 
the  patriarch  of  Constantinople  and  all  other 
prelates  who  had  signed  the  articles  of 
union  were  stigmatised  as  traitors  to  the 
Church.  On  the  other  hand,  no  effective 
help  was  sent  from  the  West  to  the  support 
of  the  Eastern  Empire  against  the  Moham- 
medan power,  and  this  circumstance  of 
course  tended  to  increase  the  estrangement 
between  the  two  Churches. 

After  the  capture  of  Constantinople  by 
the  Turks,  a.d.  1453,  and  the  ruin  of  the 
Eastern  Empire,  the  Greek  Church  was 
reduced  to  that  depressed  state  in  which  it 
has  more  or  less  remained  in  all  countries 
subjugated  by  the.  Turk.  The  scattered 
fragments  continued  to  look  to  the  patri- 
arch of  Constantinople  as  their  head,  but 
the  patriarchs  of  Constantinople  were  held 
down  in  such  abject  subjection  to  the 
Sultan,  being  obliged  to  purchase  investiture 
at  his  hands,  and  liable  to  deposition  at  his 
abitrary  will,  that  their  real  power  was  very 
small  indeed.  And  although  they  are  now 
nominated  for  life,  they  have  but  little 
freedom;  their  political  position  debars 
them  from  cordial  communion  and  co-opera- 
tion with  the  Christians  of  Greece  and 
Eussia,  with  whom  they  would  naturally 
be  inclined  to  sympathise.  A  vigorous 
attempt  was  made  during  the  pontificate  of 
Pope  Urban  VIII.  (a.d.  1623-1644),  to 
subject  the  Eastern  Christians  to  the 
Roman  See.     It  was  firmly  resisted  how- 


CHURCH,  GREEK 

ever,  esijecially  by  Cyril  Lucar,  then 
patriaroli  of  Constantinople,  an  able  and 
learned  man,  who  was  on  friendly  terms 
v/itb  severa!  reformed  divines  in  England 
and  Holland.  The  Jesuits  contrived  his 
ruin  by  accusing  him  to  the  Sultan  of 
treason,  on  virhich  charge  he  was  condemned 
and  strangled  in  a.d.  1638.  His  successor 
actually  apostatised  to  the  Roman  faith, 
but  the  next  patriarch  was  animated  by 
the  hereditary  hostility  of  his  countrymen 
to  the  Latins,  and  all  succeeding  patriarchs 
have  remained  rigidly  opposed  to  com- 
munion with  Rome. 

The  patriarchates  of  Alexandria,  Antioch 
and  Jerusalem  still  exist  in  name,  but  their 
jurisdiction  is  very  limited.  In  the  two 
former,  the  Monophysite  Christians  (see 
Jlonophysites)  are  far  more  nmnerous  than 
die  orthodox  (see  Copts,  Armenians,  also 
Jiestorians,  Jacobites,  Maronites),  while  the 
patriarchate  of  Jerusalem  contains  a  great 
variety  of  Christian  bodies,  and  only  about 
15,000  orthodox  Greeks. 

The  only  really  powerful  branch  of  the 
orthodox  Eastern  Church  is  the  Russian. 
The  conversion  of  Russia  dates  from  the 
latter  half  of  the  tenth  century.  Wlodimir, 
duke  of  Russia  and  Muscovy,  married 
Anna,  sister  of  the  emperor  Basil  the 
younger.  Through  her  influence  her 
husband  was  converted,  and  his  people 
followed  his  example.  Down  to  near  the 
end  of  the  sixteenth  centruy,  the  Russian 
j)rimate  was  appointed  by  the  patriarch  of 
Constantinople,  but  in  1589  the  patriarchate 
of  Moscow  was  established.  The  appoint- 
ments to  it  were  at  first  subject  to  confir- 
mation by  the  patriarch  of  Constantinople, 
but  before  the  end  of  the  next  century  this 
relic  of  dependence  was  removed.  An  un- 
successful attempt  was  made  by  the  Pope 
Gregory  XUL,  a.d.1590,  throughthe  instru- 
mentality of  Jesuit  agents,  to  unite,  or  rather 
subject,  the  Russian  Church  to  the  Church 
of  Rome.  Some  of  the  Russian  inhabitants 
of  Poland,  however,  were  induced  to  join 
the  Latin  Church  a.d.  1596.  They  formed 
a  community  called  the  United  Greeks  or 
Uniats,  and  the  schism  lasted  till  1839, 
when  two  millions  of  the  Uniats  under 
three  bishops  were  reconciled  to  the  national 
Church. 

Peter  the  Great  effected  great  reforms 
in  the  Russian  Church,  established  schools, 
and  abolished  persecution  for  heresy,  but 
jjrohibited  the  Jesuits  from  teaching ;  he 
suppressed  the  office  of  patriarch,  and 
appointed  an  exarch  with  limited  powers, 
responsible  partly  to  himself,  partly  to  the 
synod  of  bishops,  but  in  1720  he  abolished 
the  exarchy,  and  substituted  for  it,  as  the 
supreme  governing  body,  "the  Holy  Legis- 
lative Synod,"  consisting  originally  of  12, 


CHURCH,  GREEK 


195 


afterwards  of  an  indefinite  number  of  the 
higher  clergy  selected  by  the  Czar.  The 
head  of  the  synod  is  a  layman,  who  is  the 
representative  of  the  Czar,  and  has  a 
negative  upon  all  resolutions  until  they 
have  been  submitted  to  the  emperor.  The 
large  powers,  however,  with  wliich  the 
emperor  is  vested  have  not  been  abused 
even  by  Czars  of  the  most  despotic  dis- 
position ;  the  election  of  bishops,  although 
nominally  in  the  hands  of  the  emperor,  is 
virtually  decided  by  the  synod,  whose  advice 
on  all  ecclesiastical  subjects  is  generally 
received  with  respect.  There  is  in  fact  a 
a  remarkable  harmony  between  Church  and 
State  in  Russia,  and  although  schismatics 
are  very  numerous,  there  can  be  no  (Question 
that  the  Orthodox  Church  is  the  Chm-ch  of 
the  nation. 

After  Greece  had  shaken  off  the  Turkish 
yoke,  the  Church  was  made  independent  of 
the  patriarch  of  Constantinople,  but  other- 
wise remained  in  full  communion  with  the 
Orthodox  Eastern  Church.  It  is  governed 
by  a  synod  framed  on  the  model  of  the  Holy 
Legislative  Synod  in  Russia.  The  metro- 
politan of  Athens  is  president  of  the  synod, 
and  the  bishops  are  selected  by  the  king 
out  of  three  fit  persons  nominated  by  the 
synod. 

The  Sei-vian  Church  owes  its  origin  to  the 
labours  of  SS.  Cyril  and  Methodius,  two 
missionaries  despatched  from  Constanti- 
nople to  central  Em-ope  about  the  middle  of 
the  ninth  century.  As  the  Servian  princes 
acknowledged  a  kind  of  feudal  superiority 
in  the  Emperor  of  the  East,  so  the  Church 
recognised  the  primacy  of  the  Byzantine 
See,  but  without  acknowledging  the  patri- 
archal jurisdiction.  During  the  reign  of 
Stephen  Dushan  in  1354,  the  chief  bishop 
of  the  Servian  Church  was  constituted  a 
patriarch  by  a  national  synod,  and  the  title 
was  recognised  by  Pope  Innocent  VI. 
In  1689,  the  Servian  patriarch  having 
joined  the  Emperor  Leopold  in  an  un- 
successful attempt  to  expel  the  Turks  from 
Europe,  was  compelled  to  emigrate  with 
37,000  Servian  families  into  Hungary, 
where  he  became  archbishop  of  Carlowitz, 
and  the  head  of  a  flourishing  Church  which 
has  existed  to  the  present  day.  The 
Sultan  set  up  a  patriarchate  in  Servia, 
dependent  on  himself,  which  lasted  till  1765; 
after  which  Servia  became  a  province  of 
Constantinople  to  a.d.  1830,  when  its  inde- 
pendence was  recognised,  and  the  people 
were  allow  ed  to  elect  their  own  patriarch. 
In  1838,  when  Belgrade  was  made  the 
capital  of  Servia,  that  city  became  the  Archi- 
episcopal  See;  the  metropolitan  has  three 
suffragans,  and  enjoys  the  authority  although 
he  does  not  take  the  title  of  patriarch. 

TheBulgarian  Church  waveredin  mediasval 

0  2 


19C 


CHURCH  OF  EOME 


times  tetween  allegiance  to  the  Eoman  and 
Byzantine  Sees,  and  was  (see  above)  one  of 
the  bones  of  contention  between  the  two 
Churches,  but  ultimately  it  became 
attached  to  the  Eastern  communion  with 
an  independent  patriarchate.  The  Jesuits 
founded  a  Uniat  Church  in  1860,  but  it  had 
a  very  short-lived  existence. 
■  The  little  state  of  Montenegro,  originally 
it  part  of  the  kingdom  of  Servia,  has  with 
singular  courage  and  tenacity  of  purpose 
maintained  its  independence  both  in  secular 
and  ecclesiasticul  affairs.  For  350  years 
(a.d.  1499-1851)  it  was  governed  by  an 
hereditary  dynasty  of  prince  bishops.  At 
the  close  of  that  period  the  temporal  and 
spiritual  powers  were  separated. 

The  most  essential  points  of  difference 
between  the  Greek  and  Eoman  Churches 
are,  (i.)  the  rejection  by  the  former  of 
Papal  supremacy ;  (ii.)  the  administration  of 
the  Holy  Eucharist  in  both  kinds,  and  the 
use  of  leavened  bread ;  (ill.)  the  rejection  of 
the  Filioque  clause  in  the  Nicene  Creed; 
(iv.)  the  administration  of  the  Eucharist  to 
infants,  and  of  confirmation,  performed  not 
by  a  bishop  but  by  a  priest ;  (v.)  the  use  of 
pictures  only,  and  prohibition  of  sculptured 
forms  in  churches;  (vi.)  the  obligation  of 
parish  priests  to  be  married  men. 

The  last  official  communication  between 
the  Greek  and  Eoman  Churches  took  place 
in  1848  soon  after  the  accession  of  Pope 
Pius  IX. ;  but  the  lofty  tone  of  absolute 
authority  adopted  in  the  Papal  address 
irritated  the  feelings  of  the  Eastern  prelates, 
and  provoked  a  very  stiff  reply,  so  that  the 
prospect  of  any  reconciliation  Ijetween  these 
two  great  branches  of  the  Catholic  Church 
seems  as  distant  as  ever.  Between  the 
Greek  Orthodox  Church  and  the  Church  of 
England  there  is  and  has  long  been  far  more 
sympathy,  and  we  may  still  venture  to 
hope  that  some  terms  of  alliance,  if  not 
actual  imion,  may  in  time  be  effected 
between  them. 

[^History  of  the  Holy  Eastern  Church,  by 
J.  M.  Neale,  5  vols. ;  Mouravieffs  History  of 
the  Hussian  Church  (translated  by  Black- 
more)  ;  Lectures  on  the  Eastern  Church,  by 
A.  P.  Stanley,  late  Dean  of  Westminster ; 
History  of  the  Christian  Church,  by  J.  C. 
Eobertson,  late  Canon  of  Canterbury,  4 
vols. ;  Mosheim's  Church  History,  Stubbs' 
edition. 

For  an  account  of  the  Eastern  Christian 
bodies  not  in  communion  with  the  Ortho- 
dox Church,  see  under  Armenians,  Copts, 
Jacobites,  Maronites,  Nestorians.'] 

[W.  E.  W.  S.]- 

CHUECH  OP  EOME.  (See  Pope, 
Popery,  Council  of  Trent,  Romanism.)  The 
Church  of  Eome  is,  properly  speaking,  that 
branch  of  the  Church  Catholic  over  which 


CHUECH  OF  BOME 

the  Bishop  of  Eome  presides,  as  the  Church 
of  England  is  that  branch  over  which  the 
Archbishop  of  Canterbury  presides.  To 
trace,  even  in  outline,  the  gradual  cor- 
ruption of  doctrine  and  practice  in  the 
Eoman  Church,  the  gradual  progress  of 
Papal  power,  and  gradual  development  of 
Papal  pretensions,  would  exceed  the  limits, 
and  the  scope  of  this  Dictionary. 

For  the  purpose  of  this  work  it  will 
suffice  to  give  an  account  of  the  intro- 
duction of  Eomanism  or  Popery  into  this 
coimtry,  and  into  Ireland,  subsequently  to 
the  Eeformation.  From  the  preceding 
articles  it  will  have  been  seen  that  the 
Churches  of  England  and  Ireland  were 
canonicaUy  reformed.  The  old  Catholic 
Church  of  England,  in  accordance  with  the 
law  of  Grod  and  the  canons,  asserted  its  an- 
cient independence.  That  many  members 
of  the  Church  were  in  their  hearts  opposed 
to  this  great  movement,  is  not  only  pro- 
bable, but  certain ;  yet  they  did  not  incur 
the  sin  of  schism  by  establishing  a  sect  in 
opposition  to  the  Church  of  England,  until 
the  twelfth  year  of  Elizabeth's  reign,  when 
they  were  hurried  into  this  sin  by  foreign 
emissaries  from  the  Pope  of  Eome,  and 
certain  sovereigns  hostile  to  the  Queen. 
Mr.  Butler,  himself  a  Eomanist,  observes, 
that  "  Many  of  them  conformed  for  a  while, 
in  hopes  that  the  Queen  would  relent,  and 
things  come  round  again."  {Memoirs,  ii. 
p.  280.)  "He  may  be  right,"  says  Dr. 
Phelan,  "  in  complimenting  their  ortho- 
doxy at  the  expense  of  their  truth ;  yet  it 
is  a  curious  circumstance,  that  their  hy- 
pocrisy, while  it  deceived  a  vigilant  and 
justly  suspicious  Protestant  government, 
should  be  disclosed  by  the  tardy  candour 
of  their  own  historians."  The  admission, 
however,  is  important ;  the  admission  of  a 
Eomanist  that  Eomanism  was  for  a  season 
extinct,  as  a  community,  in  these  realms. 
The  present  Eomish  sect  cannot,  therefore, 
consistently  claim  to  be  what  the  clergy 
of  the  Church  of  England  really  and  truly 
are,  the  representatives  of  the  founders  of 
the  English  Church.  The  Eomish  clergy 
in  England,  though  they  have  orders,  have 
no  mission,  on  their  own  showing,  and  are 
consequently  schismatics.  The  Eomanists 
began  to  fall  away  from  the  Catholic  Church 
of  England,  and  to  constitute  themselves 
into  a  distinct  community  or  sect,  about  the 
year  1570,  that  is,  about  forty  years  after 
the  Church  of  England  had  suppressed 
the  Papal  usurpation.  TWs  act  was  en- 
tirely voluntary  on  .the  part  of  the  Eoman- 
ists. They  refused  any  longer  to  obey  their 
bishops ;  and,  departing  from  our  commu- 
nity, they  established  a  rival  worship,  and 
set  up  altar  against  altar.  This  sect  was 
at  first  governed  by  Jesuits  and  missionary 


CHURCH  OF  EOME 

priests,  under  the  superintendence  of  Allen, 
a  Roman  cardinal,  who  lived  in  Flanders, 
and  founded  the  colleges  at  Douay  and 
Eheims.  In  1598,  Mr.  George  Blackwell 
was  appointed  archpriest  of  the  EngUsh 
Eomanists  (see  Archpriest),  and  this  form 
of  ecclesiastical  government  prevailed 
among  them  till  1623,  when  Dr.  Bishop 
■was  ordained  titular  bishop  of  Chalcedon, 
and  sent  from  Rome  to  govern  the  Romish 
sect  in  England.  Dr.  Smith,  the  next 
bishop  of  Chalcedon,  was  banished  in  1628, 
and  the  Romanists  were  without  bishops 
till  the  reign  of  James  II.  (Palmer,  ii.  252.) 
During  the  whole  of  the  reign  of  James  I., 
and  part  of  the  following  reign,  the  Romish 
.priesthood,  both  in  England  and  in  Ire- 
land, were  in  the  interest,  and  many  of 
them  in  the  pay,  of  the  Spanish  monarchy. 
The  titulars  of  Dublin  and  Cashel  are 
particularly  mentioned  as  pensioners  of 
Spain.  The  general  memorial  of  the  Ro- 
mish hierarchy  in  Ireland,  in  1617,  was 
addressed  to  the  Spanish  court,  and  we 
are  told  by  Berrington,  himself  a  Roman- 
ist, that  the  English  Jesuits,  300  in  num- 
ber, were  all  of  the  Spanish  faction.  In 
Ireland,  as  we  have  seen  before,  the  bishops 
almost  unanimously  consented,  in  the  be- 
ginning of  Queen  Elizabeth's  reign,  to  re- 
nounce the  usurped  jurisdiction  of  the  Roman 
Pontiff,  and  consequently  there,  as  in  Eng- 
land, for  a  great  length  of  time  there  were 
scarcely  any  popish  bishops.  But  "  Swarms 
of  Jesuits,"  says  Carte,  "  and  Romish 
priests,  educated  in  the  seminaries  founded 
by  King  Philip  II.,  in  Spain  and  the  Ne- 
therlands, and  by  the  cardinal  of  Lorraine 
in  Champagne  (where,  pursuant  to  the 
vows  of  the  founders,  they  sucked  in,  as 
well  the  principles  of  rebellion,  as  of  what 
they  call  catholicity),  coming  over  to  that 
kingdom,  as  full  of  secular  as  of  religious 
views,  they  soon  prevailed  with  an  igno-. 
rant  and  credulous  people  to  withdraw  from 
the  public  service  of  the  Church."  Mac- 
gaurao,  titular  archbishop  of  Armagh,  was 
sent  over  from  Spain,  and  slain  in  an  act 
of  rebellion  against  his  sovereign.  In  1621 
there  were  two  popish  bisho]3S  in  Ireland, 
and  two  others  resided  in  Spain.  These 
persons  were  ordained  in  foreign  coun- 
tries, and  could  not  trace  their  ordina- 
tions to  the  ancient  Irish  Church.  The 
Romish  hierarchy  in  Ireland  are  thus 
the  successors,  not  of  St.  Patrick,  but 
of  certain  Spanish  and  Italian  prelates, 
who,  in  the  reign  of  James  I.,  originated, 
contrary  to  the  canons  of  the  Church,  the 
Romish  sect — a  sect  it  truly  is  in  that 
country,  since  there  can  be  but  one  Church, 
and  that  is  the  Catholic,  in  the  same  place 
(see  article  on  the  Cliurch),  and  all  that 
they  can  pretend  to  is,  that  without  having 


CHURCH  OF  ROME 


197 


any  mission,  being  therefore  in  a  state  of 
schism,  they  hold  peculiar  doctrines  and 
practices  which  the  Church  of  Ireland  may 
have  practised  and  held  for  one,  two,  three, 
or  at  the  very  most  four  hundred  out  of 
the  fourteen  hundred  years  which  have 
elapsed  since  its  foundation ;  while  even  as  a 
counterpoise  to  this,  we  may  place  the 
three  hundred  years  which  have  elapsed 
between  the  Reformation  and  the  present 
time. 

The  Roman  Catholics  then,  in  England, 
are  descended  from  those  who  in  the  reign 
of  Elizabeth  split  off  from  the  national 
Church  because  they  thought  the  Refor- 
mation had  been  carried  too  far,  just  as 
the  Puritan  party  fell  away  from  it  because 
they  thought  it  had  not  been  carried  far 
enough. 

The  alienation  of  the  Romanists  from 
the  national  Church  involved  them  in  fre- 
quent intrigues  for  the  overthrow  of  the 
established  constitution  in  Church  and 
State;  and  as  a  natural  consequence  they 
were  long  subjected,  like  most  other  Non- 
conformists, to  civil  disabilities,  and  severe 
penal  restriction  upon  the  exercise  of  their 
religion.  With  the  gradual  advance  how- 
ever of  more  enlightened  views  upon  the 
subject  of  religious  toleration,  and  the  re- 
moval or  abatement  of  most  of  the  causes 
of  political  disaffection,  the  Roman  Catho- 
lics have  been  released,  in  common  with 
Protestant  Dissenters,  from  these  galling 
fetters. 

In  1850  Pope  Pius  IX.  organised  a  new 
Roman  hierarchy  in  England  by  the  division 
of  the  country  into  twelve  dioceses.  This 
project,  which  was  stigmatised  as  the  "  Papal 
aggression,"  excited  popular  indignation  and 
alarm  to  a  degree  which  in  the  retrospect 
at  the  present  day  seems  almost  ridiculous. 
A  bill  was  carried  in  Parliament  prohibiting 
the  use  of  the  new  titles  by  the  Roman 
bishops,  but  it  was  a  futile  measure.  There 
is  no  reason  to  doubt  that  the  Roman 
Catholics  in  Great  Britain  are  thoroughly 
loyal  to  the  constitution,  and  in  Ireland 
the  causes  of  discontent  among  the  Roman 
Cathohc  population  are  agrarian  and  poli- 
tical rather  than  religious,  especially  since 
the  disestablishment  of  the  Protestant  Epis- 
copal Church.  During  the  last  few  years 
there  has  been  a  considerable  increase  in 
the  number  of  Roman  churches  and  mo- 
nastic societies  established  in  England ;  and 
the  Roman  Catholic  Church  is,  next  to  the 
Church  of  England,  the  most  numerous  of 
all  the  religious  communions  in  the  United 
Kingdom.  In  great  Britain  its  members 
may  be  computed  at  about  two  million, 
while  in  Ireland  in  1881  they  numbered 
3,951,888. — Palmer's  Treatise  on  the  Church, 
vols.  i.  &  ii. ;   Lives  of  the  Archbishops  of 


198        CHUECH-BUILDING  ACTS 

Canterbury,  by  W.  F.  Hook,  D.D. ;  Hard- 
wick's  History  of  the  Reformation. 

CHURCH-BUILDING  ACT«.  The 
confused  state  of  these  Acts  is  notorious. 
Lord  Selborne  when  Attorney-General 
brought  in  a  bUl  to  consolidate  them,  but 
was  prevented  from  carrying  it  by  the 
opposition  of  Dissenters  in  the  House  of 
Commons,  though  it  did  not  the  least  affect 
them.  "The  law  of  building  churches, 
parsonages,  and  schools,  and  the  division 
of  parishes,"  is  given  in  the  most  condensed 
form  in  a  book  by  Mr.  Trower  published 
in  1867,  and  it  has  been  altered  by  statute  or 
defined  by  dicisions  since,  to  the  extent  we 
shall  shortly  mention.  We  can  only  give 
a  very  short  summary  of  it,  omitting  many 
details. 

The  first  church-building  Act  was  43  G. 
III.  c.  108,  which  enabled  absolute  owners 
of  land  to  give  or  leave  not  more  than  five 
acres  for  building  churches  or  parsonages, 
notwithstanding  the  Mortmain  Acts  (see 
Mortmain).  The  Queen  Anne's  Bounty  Act, 
2  <&  3  Anne,  c.  20,  only  authorised  such 
gifts  for  augmentation  of  benefices,  as  some 
previous  Acts  of  17  &  29  Car.  II.  had  done 
with  respect  to  tithes  in  lay  hands.  51 
G.  III.  c.  115,  enabled  the  lord  of  a  manor  to 
grant  five  acres  of  a  common  for  a  church, 
churchyard,  parsonage  or  glebe.  58  G.  III. 
c.  45,  established  the  Church  Building 
Commissioners,  since  merged  in  the  Ec- 
clesiastical Commission,  and  Parliament 
granted  a  million  for  building  new  churches, 
hut  their  powers  and  the  general  provisions 
of  the  Act  were  not  confined  to  those 
churches,  especially  by  later  Acts.  In  that 
and  some  of  the  later  Acts  the  site  for  a 
church  was  to  be  conveyed  to  the  Com- 
missioners, and  it  is  still  prudent  to  do  so 
when  the  cost  is  defrayed  by  subscription  or 
the  site  is  given  by  someone  who  does  not 
himself  builld  the  church.  But  other- 
wise there  is  no  need  for  it;  for  the  Act  of 
Consecration  vests  the  freehold  in  the  in- 
cumbent by  8  &  9  Vict.  c.  70,  s.  13,  and  19  & 
20  Vict.  c.  104,  s.  10,  without  any  conveyance, 
the  owner  of  the  land  having  petitioned  for  the 
consecration,  without  which  it  cannot  take 
place  or  be  valid.  The  powers  given  by  58 
G.  ni.  were  somewhat  extended  by  59  G. 
III.  c.  134,  which,  among  other  things,  allows 
churches  to  be  removed  to  new  sites  by 
faculty,  with  consent  of  all  parties  inte- 
rested (s.  40).  Neither  of  these  Acts,  nor  any 
other  yet,  enables  a  tenant  for  life  to  give 
land  for  a  church,  but  only  to  sell  it  for  its 
proper  value,  which  sum  is  to  be  entailed 
instead,  and  then  all  incumbrances  on  the 
land  are  barred.  But  it  has  been  decided 
that  this  does  not  ratify  conveyances  by 
persons  who  are  not  at  all  authorised  to 
make  them,  and  such  conveyances  may  be 


CHUECH-BUILDING  ACTS 

set  aside  by  the  real  owners,  and  the  land 
ordered  to  be  reconveyed  to  them.  28  & 
29  Vict.  c.  69,  has  enabled  tenants  for  life  to 
give  an  acre  of  land  (with  wonderful  absurd- 
ity) for  a  parsonage,  though  not  for  a  church ; 
but  36  &  37  Vict.  c.  50,  and  45  &  46  Vict, 
c.  21,  enables  a  tenant  for  life,  with  the 
concurrence  of  the  next  heir,  if  there  is  one, 
or  his  guardian  (which  has  been  decided  to 
include  the  tenant  for  life  himself  if  guardian) 
and  corporations,  to  give  an  acre  for  any 
place  of  worship.  And  6  &  7  Vict.  c.  37 
(Peel's  Act),  enables  absolute  owners  to  give 
or  devise  any  quantity  of  land  or  goods  to 
the  Ecclesiastical  Commissioners  for  provid- 
ing a  new  church  for  a  new  ecclesiastical 
district.  By  the  Mortmain  Acts  money 
could  not  be  bequeathed  to  build  a  church, 
except  on  land  already  belonging  to  soma 
ecclesiastical  body ;  and  58  G.  III.  allowed 
only  £500  to  be  so  left.  There  are  sundry 
other  Acts  relating  to  church  building  and 
the  formation  of  new  parishes,  objects  which 
are  necessarily  connected.  Indeed  the  build- 
ing of  new  churches  to  be  consecrated  only 
as  chapels  of  ease  has  almost  or  quite 
ceased,  for  the  good  reasons,  that  an  un- 
conseorated  buUding  is  not  an  immovable 
incumbrance  on  the  vicar  of  the  old  church, 
who  is  bound  by  law,  or  can  be  compelled 
by  the  bishop,  to  serve  it  by  himself  or  a 
curate  for  ever  a  consecrated  chapel  of  (so- 
called)  case ;  secondly,  because  unconsecrated 
buildings  can  also  be  used  for  schools ;  and 
further,  because  the  service  can  be  read  and 
sermons  preached  by  laymen,  if  necessarj'' ; 
which  certainly  cannot  legally  be  done  in  a 
consecrated  church  or  chapel  (except  private 
ones,  which  are  only  consecrated  in  a  peculiar 
sense,  and  over  which  there  is  no  ecclesias- 
tical jurisdiction).  Laymen  can  only  read 
or  sing  the  psalms  and  canticles  and  the 
lessons  in  churches,  by  virtue  of  the  rubrics 
carefully  altering  the  usual  language,  and 
being  altered  as  to 'the  lessons  ifrom  those 
of  the  older  Prayer  Books,  so  as  not  to 
require  "  the  minister  "  to  read  those  things 
himself.  The  first  part  of  the  Litany,  in 
few  cathedrals,  is  read  solely  or  jointly  by 
the  lay  vicars  choral ;  but  it  seems  very 
doubtful  if  that  is  lawful  now  anywhere 
else,  though  it  may  possibly  have  been  so 
when  those  cathedral  statutes  were  made. 
At  any  rate  universal  usage  is  against  it. 

Although  the  incumbent  of  a  parish  has 
still  the  right  to  prevent  any  clergyman 
from  officiating  in  his  parish,  even  with  the 
approval  of  the  bishop  and  every  parishioner 
(which  ought  on  various  grounds  to  be 
abolished),  there  is  power  under  1  &  2  "W. 
IV.  c.  48,  and  1  &  2  Vict.  c.  10,  for  the  bishop 
to  authorise  anybody  else  to  build  a  church, 
two  miles  from  the  parish  church  without  the 
consent  of  the  patron  and  incumbent,  unless 


CHURCH-BUILDING  ACTS 

they  will  do  it  themselves ;  and  the  patron- 
age will  belong  to  the  person  who  builds  it, 
or  to  trustees  if  the  builders  are  numerous. 
And  such  churches  may  be  made  parish 
churches  and  a  district  assigned  to  them.  It 
is  needless  to  encumber  this  book  with  the 
formalities  required,  as  they  will  always  be 
furnished  by  diocesan  officials. 

There  is  a  clause  in  one  of  the  Church 
Building  Acts,  3  Geo.  IV.  c.  72,  s.  8,  which 
at  first  sight  appears  to  give  to  the  (now) 
ecclesiastical  commissioners  the  very  extra- 
ordinary power  of  taking  (by  compulsion) 
any  land  they  choose,  not  only  for  enlarging 
churches  (which  would  be  reasonable)  or 
rebuilding  them  (which  is  absurd  on  the 
face  of  it)  or  building  altogether  new  ones 
when  "  a  parish  is  unable  to  procure  any 
land  for  the  purpose  by  reason  of  the  in- 
ability or  unwillingness  of  any  person 
interested  in  such  (what  ?)  land  f o  agree  for 
the  sale  thereof."  Sir  W.  V.  Harcourt,  in 
supporting  a  Dissenters'  bill  in  1885  for 
giving  them  direct  power  to  take  land  by 
compulsion  for  their-  chapels,  asserted  that 
the  Church  has  that  power.  That  was 
contradicted  in  the  Times  by  a  diocesan 
chancellor,  and  reasserted  by  an  anonymous 
representative  of  the  Home  Secretary,  on 
the  strength  of  the  above  clause. 

The  "  chancellor  "  replied  that  it  does  not 
contain  any  of  the  long-established  pro- 
visions for  compulsory  taking  which  had 
existed  in  Acts  for  all  kinds  of  public  works 
long  before  the  Lands  Clauses  Act,  1845, 
and  that  it  was  plainly  intended  only  to 
deal  with  defects  of  title  and  to  supplement 
the  two  previous  Acts  of  58  &  59  Geo.  III. 
which  it  recited,  except  (as  he  said)  that  it 
might  perhaps  apply  to  enlargements  of 
churches  and  churchyards,  as  the  59  Geo. 
III.  s.  26,  does  expressly,  and  in  that  case 
the  land  is  already  indicated;  which  is 
different  from  pouncing  upon  a  piece  of  land 
anywhere  the  commissioners  like,  without 
notice  or  judicial  inquiry  of  any  kind  as  to 
the  necessity  for  it  or  the  objections  to  it ; 
a  power  which  exists  for  no  other  public 
purpose  whatever.  The  language  of  the 
Acts  is  so  confused  that  the  extent  of  the 
powers  in  question  can  be  settled  by  nothing 
short  of  a  trial  at  law,  of  which  there  is  no 
chance;  for  it  seems  to  be  well  imderstood 
that  the  commissioners  have  never  and 
never  will  try  it  against  a  real  refusal  by 
competent  persons  in  possession,  who  are 
prepared  to  fight,  though  it  would  probably 
be  effective — and  was  only  intended  to  be — 
where  the  person  in  possession  is  ready  to 
sell,  but  other  persons  "interested  in  the 
land  "  refuse  or  are  unable  to  treat.  In  that 
case  the  powers  of  the  previous  Acts  may 
be  put  in  force,  and  a  valuation  made  as  is 
usual  in  the  later  stages  of  compulsory  pur- 


CHURCHING 


109 


chnsos,  by  a  jury  or  an  arbitrator,  and  the 
money  paid  into  Court.  It  is  material  to 
observe  that  the  technical  words  "  by  com- 
pulsion "  do  not  appear  in  any  of  the  three 
Acts,  and  that  it  is  "accept  and  take"  in 
the  principal  Act,  to  which  the  others  were 
subsidiarj'.  It  is  therefore  useless  to  ask 
the  commissioners  to  try  to  obtain  land 
for  church  building  by  compulsion ;  and  it 
would  be  strange  indeed  if  they  could.    [G.] 

CHURCHING  OF  WOMEN;  or  thanks- 
giving of  women  after  child-birth.  I.  This 
custom  was,  no  doubt,  derived  from  the 
rite  of  purification,  which  is  enjoined  so 
particularly  in  the  twelfth  chapter  of  Le- 
viticus, and  which  was  observed,  with  its 
attendant  ceremonies  and  offerings,  by  the 
Mother  of  our  Lord.  Nor  indeed  may  the 
Church  be  so  reasonably  supposed  to  have 
taken  up  this  rite  from  the  practice  of  the 
Jews,  as  she  may  be,  that  she  began  it  in 
imitation  of  the  Blessed  Virgin,  who  thoush 
she  was  rather  sanctified  than  defiled  by  the 
birth  of  our  Lord,  and  so  had  no  need  of 
purification  from  any  imcleannesa,  whether 
legal  or  moral ;  yet  wisely  and  humbly  sub- 
mitted to  this  rite,  and  offered  her  praise, 
together  with  her  Blessed  Son,  in  the  temple. 
And  that  from  hence  this  usage  was  derived 
among  Christians  seems  probable,  not  only 
from  its  being  so  universal  and  ancient, 
that  the  beginning  of  it  can  hardly  any- 
where be  found  ;  but  also  from  the  practice 
of  the  Eastern  Church,  where  the  mother 
still  brings  the  child  along  with  her,  and 
presents  it  to  God  on  her  churching -day. — 
Wheatly,  chap.  xiii.  p.  502. 

In  the  Greek  Church  the  time  for  per- 
forming this  office  is  limited  to  be  on  the 
fortieth  day.  Dionysius  of  Alexandria,  quoted 
by  Beveridge  (Concil.  tom.  ii.  p.  4),  lays  it 
down  as  a  matter  about  which  there  could 
be  no  doubt,  that  a  woman  ought  not  to  be 
present  at  church,  or  receive  the  Holy  Com- 
munion within  forty  days  after  her  having 
given  birth  to  a  child.  In  the  West  the 
time  was  never  strictly  determined,  though 
St.  Augustine  speaks  of  the  forty  days 
required  by  the  old  dispensation  being  still 
binding  under  the  new  {Qumst.  in  Levit.  lib. 
iii.  quEest.  64.)  When  the  other  Augustine 
wrote  from  Britain  to  Gregory,  and,  amongst 
other  things,  asked  his  advice  on  this  matter, 
"you  know  the  time  required  in  the  Old 
Testament,"  was  the  answer,  "  yet  if  she 
enter  into  church  and  render  thanks  the 
very  hour  she  has  given  birth,  she  sins  not." 
— Bede,  i.  27. 

Our  present  rubric  does  not  pretend  to 
limit  the  day  when  the  woman  shall  be 
churched,  but  only  supposes  that  she  will 
come  "at  the  usual  time  after  her  de- 
livery." The  "usual  time"  is  now  about 
a  month,  for   the  woman's   weakness  will 


200 


CHUECHING 


seldom  pennit  her  coming  sooner.  And 
if  she  be  not  able  to  come  so  soon,  sbe  is 
allowed  to  stay  a  longer  time,  the  Church 
not  expecting  her  to  return  her  thanks  for 
a  blessing  before  it  is  received. — Wheatly,  p. 
503. 

II.  The  service  itself  was  probably,  in 
eirly  times,  left  to  the  discretion  of  the 
minister ;  at  all  events,  there  is  no  such 
ofSce  in  the  ancient  Sacramentaries,  though 
forms  are  to  be  found  of  later  date,  which 
are  given  by  Martene  (de  Bit.  Eccl.  ii.  136), 
and  Goar  (p.  267).  Our  present  service  is 
taken  from  the  service  for  the  purification 
of  women  in  the  Sarum  Manual.  The  old 
title  was  retained  in  1549,  but  altered  in 
1552,  lest  there  should  be  the  lingering  idea 
that  the  woman  comes  to  get  rid  of  a  defile- 
ment, instead  of  to  offer  up  thanksgiving  for 
God's  mercies. 

III.  According  to  the  rubric,  before  the 
Kefonnation,  the  "convenient  place"  for 
the  woman  to  kneel  was  the  church  door. 

This  was  altered  in  1549  to  "quire 
door,"  and  in  1552  to  "  nigh  unto  the  Table," 
Bishop  Andrewes  used  the  choir  door.  In 
bishop  Wren's  injunctions  for  the  diocese  of 
Norwich  (1636)  and  Bishop  Brian  Duppas's 
articles  of  visitation  "  a  side  near  the  com- 
munion table"  is  recommended.  But  no 
general  rule  is  either  prescribed  or  observed 
as  to  time  or  place,  and  therefore  these  are 
matters  which  fall  within  the  office  of  the 
ordinary  to  determine.  Many  read  the  office 
just  before  the  General  Thanksgiving:  others, 
though  not  so  usually,  at  some  part  of  the 
Communion  Service  ;  some  at  the  altar, 
others  at  the  desk :  the  woman  in  some 
churches  occupies  a  seat  specially  set  apart 
for  this  office ;  in  others  she  kneels  at  the 
altar,  and  there  makes  her  offering.  And  in 
others  a  custom  prevails  of  performing  this 
service  at  some  time  distinct  from  the  office 
of  Common  Prayer. 

IV.  The  "decent  apparel"  required  by 
the  rubric  is  supposed  to  refer  to  a  veil, 
which  was  usually  worn.  (See  Hale's  Pre- 
cedents, p.  259).  In  1549,  the  rubric  ran, 
"  the  woman  that  is  purified  must  offer  her 
'Clirisome' and  other  accustomed  offerings." 
(See  Chrisome.)  The  former  was  omitted  in 
1552.  But,  besides  the  accustomed  offering, 
the  woman  is  to  make  a  yet  much  better 
and  greater  offering,  namely,  an  offering  of 
herself,  to  be  a  reasonable,  holy,  and  lively 
sacrifice  to  God.  For  the  rubric  declares, 
that  "if  there  be  a  communion,  it  is  con- 
venient that  she  receive  the  holy  com- 
munion ; "  that  being  the  most  solemn  way 
of  praising  God  for  him  by  whom  she  re- 
ceived both  the  present  and  all  other  God's 
mercies  towards  her ;  and  a  means  also  to 
bind  'herself  more  strictly  to  spend  those 
days  in  his  service,   which,  by  this  late 


CHUECHWAKDENS 

deliverance,  he  hath   added  to  her  life. — 
Wheatly,  p.  510.    [H.] 

CHURCH    BATES.     Compulsory    pay-        j 
ment  of  church   rates   being  abolished  by 
31  &  32  Vict.  c.  109,  except  a  few  which        | 
were  pledged  for  money   borrowed  imder        • 
special    Acts  of   Parliament    for    building 
churches,  there  is  no  need  to  say  much 
about  them.     It  is  still  lawful,  however,  for 
trustees,  corporations,    and    other    persons 
under  disability  to  pay  a  voluntary  church 
rate.    A  rate  may  stiU  be  agreed  upon  by 
a  vestry  meeting  as  before,  but  nobody  is 
bound    to    pay  it.     The    impropriator    of 
great  tithes  was  not  exempt  by  reason  of 
his  being  liable  to  repair  the  chancel,  which 
liability  has  not  been  taken  away. 

CHURCHWARDENS.  These  are  very 
ancient  officers,  and  by  the  common  law  are 
a  lay  corporation,  to  take  care  of  the  goods 
of  the  church,  and  may  sue  and  be  sued  as 
the  representatives  of  the  parish.  Churches 
are  to  be  repaired  by  the  churchwardens,  at 
the  charge  of  all  the  inhabitants,  or  such  as 
occupy  houses  or  lands  within  the  parish. 

In  the  ancient  episcopal  synods,  the 
bishops  were  wont  to  summon  divers 
creditable  persons  out  of  every  parish,  to 
give  information  of,  and  to  attest  the  dis- 
orders of  clergy  and  people.  They  were 
called  testes  synodales;  and  were,  in  after 
times,  a  kind  of  empanelled  jury,  consisting 
of  two,  three,  or  more  persons  in  every 
parish,  who  were,  upon  oath,  to  present  all 
heretics  and  other  irregular  persons.  And 
these,  in  process  of  time,  became  standing 
oflSoers  in  several  places,  especially  in  great 
cities,  and  from  hence  were  called  synods- 
men,  and  by  corruption  sidesmen :  they  are 
also  sometimes  called  questmen,  from  the 
nature  of  their  office,  in  making  inquiry 
concerning  offences.  And  these  sidesmen 
or  questmen,  by  Canon  90,  are  to  be  chosen 
yearly  in  Easter  week,  by  the  minister  and 
parishioners  (if  they  can  agree),  otherwise 
to  be  appointed  by  the  ordinary  of  the 
diocese.  But  for  the  most  part  this  whole 
office  is  now  devolved  upon  the  church- 
wardens, together  with  that  other  office 
which  their  name  more  properly  imports,  of 
taking  care  of  the  church  and  the  goods 
thereof,  which  has  long  been  their  function. 

By  Canon  118.  The  churchwardens  and 
sidesmen  shall  be  chosen  the  first  week 
after  Easter,  or  some  week  following, 
according  to  the  direction  of  the  ordinary. 

And  by  Canon  89.  All  churchwardens 
or  questmen  in  every  parish  shall  be  chosen 
by  the  joint  consent  of  the  minister  and  the 
parishioners,  if  it  may  be;  but  if  they 
cannot  agree  upon  such  a  choice,  then  the 
minister  shall  choose  one,  and  the  parish- 
ioners another ;  and  without  such  a  joint  or 
several  choice,  none  shall  tike  upon  them 


CHUECHWAKDENS 

to  be  cliiircliwardens.  But  if  the  parish  is 
entitled  by  custom  to  choose  both  church- 
wardens, then  the  parson  is  restrained  of  his 
xight  under  this  canon.  (See  Dean  Prideaux's 
Practical  Guide  to  the  Duties  of  Church- 
wardens in  the  execution  of  their  Office,  atid 
'Cripps'  Practical  Treatise  on  the  Laws  of 
the  Church.) 

Since  the  abolition  of  compulsory  church 
rates,  the  functions  of  churchwardens  have 
become  less  important.  And  it  seems 
strange  that  not  even  an  attempt  was  made 
by  the  bishops  or  anybody  else  in  Parlia- 
ment, when  that  was  done  to  prevent  any 
but  churchmen  from  being  elected  church- 
wardens, though  there  is  that  provision  for 
new  parishes  under  1  &  2  W.  IV.  c.  38.  In 
some  parishes,  by  ancient  custom,  the 
parishioners  elect  both  wardens.  It  should 
be  understood  that  as  soon  as  they  are 
appointed  there  is  really  no  such  thing  as 
■"  the  vicar's  churchwarden,"  or  "  the 
people's."  At  Doncaster,  and  possibly  else- 
where, by  old  custom,  the  mayor  appoints 
one  churchwarden,  and  the  vicar  the  other. 
When  a  vicar  is  absent,  the  curate  is 
entitled  to  take  the  chair  at  vestry  meetings, 
and  to  nominate  one  churchwarden.  In 
some  places  there  are  more  than  two.  But 
they  are  a  corporation,  and  can  only  act 
jointly,  and  not  by  a  majority.  They  have 
no  right  to  alter  anything  in  a  church,  or  to 
do  more  than  ordinary  repairs,  without  a 
faculty.  It  has  even  been  held  that  they 
must  not  themselves  remove  the  most  un- 
questionably illegal  "  ornament"  introduced 
by  the  incumbent ;  but  the  limits  of  their 
power  in  that  respect  have  not  yet  been 
determined  by  the  supreme  ecclesiastical 
Oourt.  It  is  said  that  the  vicar  alone 
cannot  remove  the  sexton  or  vergers  who 
take  care  of  the  church  and  act  under  the 
churchwardens  in  seating  the  people.  And 
though  the  Act  7  &  8  Vict.  c.  50,  gave  the 
archdeacon  power  to  suspend  or  remove  a 
parish  clerk,  that  was  forgotten  in  the  case 
of  sextons  or  vergers.  They  can  however 
be  removed  for  proved  misconduct  by  the 
Ticar  or  churchwardens.  A  mere  grave- 
digging  sexton  is  said  to  be  under  the  vicar 
only. 

The  seating  of  parishioners  in  church  is 
one  function  still  remaining  to  church- 
wardens; and  in  this  they  are  only  the 
officers  of  the  ordinary  or  bishop ;  and  must 
act  with  discretion,  and  not  capriciously,  or 
so  as  to  deter  parishioners  from  coming  to 
church,  and  certainly  not  in  accordance  with 
other  theories  of  those  who  think  the  law 
must  be  wha-tever  they  wish  it  to  be,  and 
not  what  every  ecclesiastical  judge  has  said 
that  it  is.  Even  an  alleged  custom  for 
them  to  place  and  displace  summarily  is 
bad.     (PrideauXi  p.  110.)     We  are  speak- 


CHURCHWARDENS 


201 


ing  of  ordinary  parish  churches,  and  not  of 
those  in  which  pews  or  sittings  may  be  sold 
or  let  under  certain  Acts  of  Parliament,  or 
may  be  required  to  be  unappropriated.  The 
parishioners  are  entitled  to  have  sittings 
assigned  to  them  as  far  as  possible,  subject 
to  their  coming  to  church  in  time.  And 
Rolfe,  B.,  held  in  Reynolds  v.  Monkton  (2  M. 
&  Rob.  384)  that  churchwardens  must 
exercise  a  reasonable  discretion  in  seating 
them,  and  may  even  remove  intruders,  or 
those  who  unduly  resist  them.  When  sit- 
tings have  been  assigned  to  a  man  and  his 
family,  they  must  not  be  capriciously  taken 
away  again  (^Groves  v.  R.  of  Hornsey,  1 
Hag.  195).  No  payment  for  them  can  be 
enforced  or  demanded,  but  it  is  frequently 
agreed  to,  and  preferred  by  some  congrega- 
tions to  other  modes  of  raising  money  for 
church  expenses.  By  Canon  85,  the  church- 
wardens are  to  "  see  that  at  every  meeting 
of  the  congregation  peace  be  well  kept;" 
and  consequently  they  remove  disorderly 
persons.  And  by  Canon  52  they  are  to  sec 
that  a  record  is  kept  of  all  strange  preachers, 
and  that  no  one  preaches  who  is  not  duly 
licensed.  But  that  is  practically  obsolete. 
They  are  not  solely  ecclesiastical  officers, 
being  sometimes  overseers  of  the  poor ;  and 
for  that  reason  it  was  decided  in  R.  v. 
Stephens,  3  B.  &  S.  333,  that  the  inhabi- 
tants of  "  new  parishes  for  all  ecclesiastical 
purposes,"  do  not  lose  the  right  of  voting 
for  churchwardens  of  the  old  parish,  though 
it  is  now  settled  that  they  do  lose  all  other 
rights  in  the  old  church  (^Fuller  v.  Alford,  10 
Q.  B.  D.  418).  Since  the  abolition  of  church 
rates  it  has  been  held  that  churchwardens 
are  not  personally  bound  to  pay  the  visitation 
fees  if  they  have  no  funds  (  Vdey  v.  Fertwet, 
L.  R.  5  Q.  B.  573).  But  they  must  go  and 
be  sworn  in — or  rather,  make  the  statutable 
declaration ;  and  cannot  act  until  they  do. 
It  maybe  done  however  after  the  visitation. 
If  there  is  a  dispute  about  who  is  elected, 
the  archdeacon,  or  the  chancellor  or  commis- 
sary at  an  episcopal  visitation,  cannot  deter- 
mine it,  for  it  belongs  to  the  temporal  courts. 
He  must  admit  both  claimants.  But  it 
seems,  on  the  balance  of  the  decisions,  that 
'  if  the  commissary  is  satisfied  that  one  who 
comes  to  be  admitted  was  plainly  not  elected, 
he  may  and  should  decline  to  admit  him, 
and  that  such  a  return  to  a  mandamus  is 
good,  provided  he  can  maintain  it  on  the 
trial.  (if.  V.  Stephens  in  Q.  B.,  cited  in 
Prideaux,  and  R.  v.  Williams  (in  1828),  8 
B.  &  C.  681,  and  3  Man.  &  Ry.  403.)  But 
the  law  on  this  point  seems  so  uncertain,  or 
the  distinctions  so  fine,  that  the  safer  way  is 
to  admit  all  the  claimants  who  have  any 
appearance  of  having  been  elected,  even  rival 
ones,  and  let  them  fight  it  out  elsewhere. 
Old  churchwardens  remain  in  office  till  new 


202 


CHUKCHYARD 


ones  are  admitted;  and  the  full  number 
must  be  elected,  whatever  it  may  be,  accord- 
ing to  the  custom  of  that  parish,  or  it  is  no 
election  at  all. 

Another  somewhat  obscure  function  of 
churchwardens,  according  to  the  last  rubric 
in  the  communion  service,  is  to  dispose  of 
the  alms  collected  at  the  offertory  to  such 
pious  and  charitable  uses  as  they  and  the 
minister  shall  think  fit :  but  if  they  disagree, 
the  alms  shall  be  disposed  of  as  the  ordinary, 
i.e.  the  bishop,  shall  appoint.  This  does  not 
prevent  collecting  money  for  any  special 
XJurpose  announced  beforehand  ;  and  if  any 
churchwardens  should  dispute  it,  the  ordi- 
nary would  be  sure  to  decide  that  oblations 
must  be  applied  for  the  purpose  for  which 
they  were  offered,  and  therefore  for  that 
which  was  announced  beforehand.  We 
have  heard  of  a  practice  of  dividing  the  alms 
into  three  parts  for  the  vicar  and  chuich- 
wardens  to  dispose  of  individually ;  but  that 
is  illegal,  and  clearly  not  the  meaning  of  the 
rubric.  Church  expenses  are  generally  now 
provided  for  by  the  offertory  so  announced 
beforehand,  and,  whoever  dispenses  the 
money,  the  vicar  and  churchwardens  are 
equally  entitled  to  see  the  accounts ;  which 
in  all  well-ordered  parishes  are  periodically 
published,  including  the  produce  of  all 
collections,  sometimes  even  to  the  coins 
given.  (See  Sidesmen,  and  Visitation.')  [G.] 

CHURCHYARD.  The  ground  ad- 
joining to  the  church,  in  which  the  dead 
are  buried.  As  to  the  original  of  burial- 
places,  many  writers  have  observed,  that, 
at  the  first  erection  of  churches,  no  part 
of  the  adjacent  ground  was  allotted  for  the 
interment  of  the  dead ;  but  some  place  for 
this  purpose  was  appointed  at  a  further 
distance.  The  laws  of  the  empire  forbade 
burial  within  the  walls  of  cities,  and  for  the 
first  five  or  six  centuries  few  or  none  but 
Christian  emperore  were  interred  in  the 
precincts  of  town  churches.  In  the  time  of 
Gregory  the  Great,  monks  and  priests  pro- 
cured leave  for  liberty  of  sepulture  in 
churches  or  places  adjoining  to  them.  But, 
by  the  9th  Canon,  entitled  De  non  sepeli- 
endo  in  ecclesiis,  this  custom  of  sepultnre  in 
churches  was  restrained,  and  no  such  liberty 
allowed  for  the  future,  unless  the  person 
was  a  priest  or  some  holy  man,  who,  by  the 
merits  of  his  past  life,  might  deserve  such 
peculiar  favour.  In  the  East,  however, 
about  the  year  900,  the  Emperor  Leo  VI. 
(Novell.  53)  abrogated  the  laws  against 
burial  in  cities.  In  the  English  Church, 
prior  to  the  Norman  Conquest,  most  of  the 
burial  grounds  belonged  to  the  monastic 
houses.  They  were  originally  intended  for 
the  inmates  only,  but  being  considered 
more  sacred,  and  therefore  safer,  than  other 
grounds,  the  right  of  interment  in  them  was 


CIECUMOELLIONS 

purchased  by  a  large  number  of  the  laity, 
either  through  gifts  of  land,  or  other  bene- 
factions, or  the  payment  of  mortuary  fees. 

By  Canon  85.  The  churchwardens  or 
questmen  snail  take  care  that  the  church- 
yards be  well  and  sufBciently  repaired, 
fenced,  and  maintained  with  walls,  rails, 
or  pales,  as  have  been  in  each  place  accus- 
tomed, at  their  charges  unto  whom  by  law 
the  same  appertains. 

The  churchyard  is  the  freehold  of  the 
parson :  but  it  is  the  common  burial-place 
of  the  dead,  and  for  that  reason  it  is  to  be 
fenced  at  the  charge  of  the  parishioners, 
unless  there  is  a  custom  to  the  contrary, 
or  for  a  particular  person  to  do  it,  in  re- 
spect of  his  lands  adjoining  to  the  church- 
yard; and  that  must  be  tried  at  commoa 
law.  But  though  the  freehold  is  in  the 
parson,  he  cannot  cut  down  trees  growing 
there,  except  for  the  necessary  repairs  of 
the  chancel ;  because  they  are  planted  and 
grow  there  for  the  ornament  and  shelter 
of  the  church.     (See  Bu)-ial,ani  Cemetery. y 

CIBORIUM.  1.  An  ornamental  canopy 
overshadowing  the  altar.  "  This  was  raised 
in  the  form  of  a  little  turret  upon  fouF 
pillars  at  each  corner  of  the  altar."  2. 
Afterwards  the  pyx  went  by  the  name  of 
"  Ciborium"  which  originally  is  an  Egyptian 
name  for  the  husk  of  a  beam — ^thence  it 
cannot  mean  a  cup  or  bowl. — Bingham,  bk. 
viii.  c.  vi.  sect.  19. 

CIRCUMCELLIONS.  A  fanatical  sect 
of  the  Donatist  Christians  in  Africa,  io  the 
fourth  century,  being  so  called,  because  they 
rambled  round  the  cottages  (cellje)  of  the 
peasantry,  having  no  fixed  residence.  They 
affected  zeal  for  the  public  reformation  and 
redressing  of  grievances  ;  they  manumitted 
slaves  without  their  master's  leave,  forgave 
debts  which  were  none  of  their  own,  and 
committed  a  great  many  other  insolences: 
they  were  headed  by  Maxides  and  Faser. 
They  are  mentioned  by  St.  Augustine 
frequently,  as  being  notoriously  violent  and 
wicked.  At  the  beginning  of  their  disorders 
they  marched  only  with  staves  (Aug.  in 
Ps.  X.,  V.  5),  which  they  called  the  staves  of 
Israel,  in  allusion  to  the  custom  of  the 
Israelites  eating  the  paschal  lamb  with  staves 
in  their  hands,  but  afterwards  they  made 
use  of  all  sorts  of  arms  against  the  Catholics. 
Donatus  called  them  the  saints'  chiefs,  and 
revenged  himself  by  their  means  upon  the 
Catholics.  A  mistaken  zeal  for  martyrdom 
made  these  people  destroy  themselves;  some 
of  them  threw  themselves  down  precipices, 
others  leaped  into  the  fire,  and  some  cut 
their  own  throats :  so  that  their  bishops, 
not  being  able  to  prevent  such  horrible  and 
unnatural  violences,  were  obliged  to  apply 
themselves  to  the  magistracy  to  put  an  end 
to  their  phrensy. — August.  Eseres.  69 ;  C. 


CmCUMOISION 

Gaudent.  i.  28,  32  :  Litt.  Petil.  i.  16,  ii.  19, 
&c. ;  Theod.  Hair.  lib.  iv.  c.  6. ;  Soames' 
Mosheim,  i.  290-292. 

CIRCUMCISION  OP  JESUS  CHRIST. 
This  feast  is  celebrated  by  the  Church,  to 
commemorate  the  active  obedience  of  our 
Lord  la  fulfilling  all  righteousness,  which 
is  oiie  branch  of  the  meritorious  cause  of 
our  redemption ;  and  by  that  means  ab- 
rogating the  severe  injunctions  of  the 
Mosaioal  establishment,  and  putting  us 
under  the  grace  of  the  Gospel.  In  the 
earliest  ages  of  the  Church,  the  day  was 
kept  as  the  Octave  of  the  Nativity,  and  it 
was  not  till  the  sixth  century  that  both  the 
Octave  and  the  Feast  of  the  Circumcision 
were  observed  on  it.  But  one  time,  indeed, 
it  was  kept  as  a  fast,  as  a  protest  on  the 
part  of  the  Christians  against  the  excesses  of 
the  people  on  the  heathen  festival  of  the 
Saturnalia  with  which  it  coincided.  It  is 
not  mentioned  in  the  Calendar  of  Buclerius 
(fourth  century)  or  in  the  Comes  of  St. 
Jerome,  except  as  Octava  Domini ;  but  there 
is  a  mass  for  it  in  the  Gelasian  Sacramentary, 
and  in  the  Gregorian,  though  it  is  still  called 
the  Octave,  the  circumcision  is  referred  to  in 
the  proper  Preface  and  Benediction.  In  the 
Galilean  Lectionaries  (see  Mabillon,  p.  112) 
and  in  the  Sarum  Missal  it  is  named  as  it  is 
now.  The  rubric  at  the  end  of  the  gospel 
Avas  inserted  by  Bishop  Cosin,  and  differs 
from  that  of  1552  insomuch  that  it  ordere 
the  Collect,  Epistle  and  Gospel  to  be  used 
every  day  till  the  Epiphany,  whereas  the 
latter  only  provided  for  the  Sunday. 

It  is  one  of  the  scarlet  days  at  the  Uni- 
versities. 

CIRTA,  Council  of  (African),  a.d.  305, 
held  to  elect  a  bishop  in  the  place  of  a 
traitor. 

CISTERCIANS.  In  a.d.  1098,  Robert, 
Abbot  of  Molesme,  in  Burgundy,  having 
employed,  in  vain,  his  most  zealous  efforts 
to  revive  the  decaying  piety  and  discipline 
of  his  convent,  and  to  oblige  his  monks  to 
observe  more  exactly  the  rule  of  St.  Benedict, 
retired  with  about  twenty  monks  to  a  place 
called  Citeaux,  near  Dijon,  in  the  diocese  of 
Chalons.  In  -this  retreat  Robert  founded 
the  famous  order  of  the  Cistercians,  which 
was  organised  by  his  two  successors  Alberic, 
and  the  Englishman  Stephen  Harding ;  but 
the  greatest  genius  and  saint  of  the  order  was 
St.  Bernard,  Abbot  of  Clairvaux  a.d.  1115. 
The  Cistercians  spread  with  astonishing 
rapidity  through  the  greatest  part  of  Europe 
during  the  twelfth  century,  and  their  houses 
were  enriched  with  the  most  liberal  and 
splendid  donations.  By  the  year  1151  there 
were  more  than  500  Cistercian  houses  in 
Europe.  The  great  and  fundamental  law  of 
this  new  fraternity  was  the  rule  of  St. 
Benedict,  which  was  to  be  rigorously  cb- 


CLEAESTOEY 


203. 


served.  Alike  in  their  habits  of  life,  their 
dress,  their  fare,  their  ceremonial,  music, 
vestments,  and  the  structure  and  adornment 
of  their  churches,  the  strictest  simplicity- 
was  to  be  enforced.  But  all  these  rules 
were  relaxed  with  the  lapse  of  time  and 
accession  of  wealth.  (See  Benedictines.) 
The  first  Cistercian  monastery  in  England 
wa.s  that  of  Waverley,  in  Surrey,  1129. 
Rievaux,  Tintern,  Fountains,  and  others  of 
less  note  soon  followed ;  and  by  the  reign  of 
Edward  I.  there  were  sixty-one  Cistercian 
monasteries  in  England. — Monast.  Angl. ; 
Helyot,  Hist,  des  Ord.  Eelig.  tom.  v.  c.  33; 
Robertson,  Gh.  Hist.  ii.  p.  771,  iii.  p.  6-12  ; 
Annates  Cistercienses ;  Mabillon,  Annates 
Benedict,  vols.  5  and  6. 

CITATION.  "A  citation  is  a  judicial 
act,  whereby  the  defendant  by  authority  of 
the  judge  (the  plaintiff  requesting  it)  is 
commanded  to  appear  to  enter  into  suit,  at 
a  certain  day,  in  a  place  where  justice  is- 
administered."  (Phillimore,  Eccl.  Law.) 
Citations  were  to  be  read  after  the  offertory ; 
but  the  only  kind  of  citation  now  heard  is 
the  "  Si  quis  "  of  candidates  for  Holy  Orders, 
calling  on  any  one  who  knows  anything 
against  the  candidate,  to  declare  the  same 
to  the  bishop.     (See  Orders,  Holy.) 

CLAIRE,  ST.  A  religious  order  of 
women  in  the  Romish  Church,  the  second 
that  St.  Francis  instituted.  This  order 
was  founded  in  1213,  and  was  confirmed 
by  Innocent  III.,  and  after  him  by  Hono- 
rius  III.,  in  1223.  It  took  its  name  from 
its  first  abbess  and  nun,  Clara  of  Assisi,  and 
was  afterwards  divided  into  Damianists 
and  Urbanists ;  the  first  follow  the  ancient 
discipline  in  all  its  rigour,  but  the  other 
the  rule  with  Urban  IV.'s  allowance. — 
Hist,  des  Ord.  Belig.  torn.  vii.  c.  25. 

CLARENDON,  CONSTITUTIONS  OF. 
Certain  constitutions  made  in  the  reign  of 
Henry  II.,  a.d.  1164,  in  a  parliament  or 
council  held  at  Clarendon,  a  village  three 
miles  distant  from  Salisbury.  They  were 
sixteen  in  number,  and  were  intended  to 
uphold  the  supremacy  of  the  Crown  in 
ecclesiastical  affairs,  including  the  right  to 
decide  questions  of  patronage  ;  to  try  crimi- 
nous clerks;  to  hold  the  court  of  final 
appeals ;  to  regulate  the  election  of  prelates ; 
to  give  or  withhold  permission  for  clergy, 
especially  dignitaries,  to  quit  the  realm  ;  and 
to  require  the  discharge  from  the  latter  of 
baronial  duties.  (See  Stubbs'  Select  Char- 
ters, 129;  Constit.  Hist.  i.  464.)  These 
constitutions  were  the  principal  ground- 
work of  the  struggle  between  Henry  II.  and 
Thomas  Becket. 

CLEARSTORY.  That  part  of  a  church 
with  aisles  which  rises  on  the  nave  arches 
clear  of  the  aisle  roofs.  This  has  been  already 
described  in  cathedrals,  which  have  mostly 


204 


CLEMENT 


vaulted  roofs,  of  whicli  the  main  ribs  spring 
from  shafts  or  corbels  between  the  clearstory- 
windows,  and  the  top  of  the  vault  is  seldom 
higher  than  the  clearstory,  so  that  fiat  tie- 
beams  of  the  wooden  roof  lie  right  across 
the  walls  clear  of  the  vaulting.  _  In  churches 
with  open  wooden  roofs  not  imitating  vault- 
ing this  is  not  so,  except  that  the  main  ribs 
or°  principals  of  high-pitched  roofs  often 
spring  from  about  the  middle  of  the  clear- 
story windows.  Many  old  clearstories  were 
raised  in  Perpendicular  times,  to  make 
larger  windows,  while  the  roofs  were  lowered 
considerably  below  the  ancient  height,  and 
still  more  below  the  ancient  pitch,  notwith- 
standing the  raising  of  the  walls.  Some- 
times this  was  done  in  order  to  use  the  old 
beams  again,  of  which  the  ends  had  rotted 
from  contact  with  the  walls ;  and  also  for 
the  sake  of  larger  windows  to  be  filled  with 
painted  glass ;  which  however  is  better 
absent  there  as  it  darkens  the  church,  and 
the  glass  cannot  be  clearly  seen.  It  is  only 
tolerable  round  an  apse.  The  common 
spelling  of  the  word  as  "clerestory"  is 
absurd,  for  it  means  nothing  but  the  clear 
story  above  the  aisle  roofs.     [G.] 

CLEMENT,  ST.,  Bishop  and  Martyr; 
commemorated  in  the  English  Calendar  on 
Nov.  23.  He  is  supposed  to  be  the  Clement 
mentioned  by  St.  Paul  as  one  of  his  fellow- 
labourers  (PhiL  iv.  3).  He  is  said  to  have 
been  made  bishop  of  Home  in  91.  His 
1st  epistle  to  the  Corinthians  (about  a.d.  96) 
was  for  a  time  read  in  public  service,  and 
esteemed  almost  equally  with  the  Canonical 
Epistles.  A  MS.  of  this  epistle  is  appended 
to  the  Codex  Alexandrinus  in  the  British 
Huseum.  The  legend  is  that  be  suffered  under 
Trajan,  being  cast  into  the  sea  bound  to  an 
:anchor,  which  is  his  emblem.     [H.] 

CLERGY.  (See  Bishop,  Presbyter, 
Priest,  Beacon,  Apostolical  Succession, 
Orders.)  The  general  name  given  to  the 
hody  of  ecclesiastics  of  the  Christian  Church, 
in  contradistinction  to  the  laity.  It  is  de- 
rived from  K\ijpos,  a  lot  or  portion,  not  that 
they  were  chosen  by  lot,  for  that  was  not 
the  case;  but  that  they  are  "de  sorte 
Domini,"  or  that  "  Ipse  Dominus  sors,"  the 
Lord  is  their  lot  or  inheritance.  (St.  Jerom. 
Bp.  2,  ad  nepot.)  The  distinctiod  into 
clergy  and  laity  was  derived  from  the 
Jewish  Church,  and  adopted  into  the  Chris- 
tian Church  by  the  Apostles  themselves. 
St.  Paul  (1  Cor.  xiv.  16),  and  St.  Clement 
of  Rome,  and  other  of  the  earliest  writers 
refer  to  it  TertuUian  says  that  it  was  a 
sign  of  the  heretics  to  confound  the  offices 
■of  clergy  and  laity  together  (de  Prescript,  c. 
41).  It  was  indeed  said  by  the  wi-iter 
Tinder  the  name  of  St.  Ambrose,  "  omnibus 
■concessum  est  et  evangelizare,  et  baptizare  " 
.&c.  (Ambrose,  or  Hil.  in  EpTi.  iv.  p.  948),  but 


CLEEGY 

this  is  not  to  do  away  with  the  distinction, 
as  St.  Jerome  shows  when  he  speaks  of  the 
"  laical  priesthood."  (St.  Jer.  Dial.  v.  Luci- 
fer, tom.  ii.  p.  136.)  Clemens  Alexandrinus 
speaks  of  St.  John,  after  his  return  from 
Patmos,  setting  apart  men  for  the  clergy ; 
and  wherever  a  body  of  Christian  converts 
was  numerous  enough  to  be  formed  into  a 
separate  church,  clergy  were  always  or- 
dained to  minister  to  them.  (Epiphan.  Hser. 
75.)  See  also  St.  Chrys.  in  Ps.  cxiii.  v.  19  ; 
St.  Ambrose,  Be  dign.  Sacerd.  c.  iiL;  St. 
Cyprian,  Ep.  59  ad  Com. 

I.  The  clergy  originally  consisted  only  of 
bishops,  priests,  and  deacons ;  but,  in  the 
third  century,  many  inferior  orders  were 
appointed,  as  subservient  to  the  oifice  of 
deacon,  such  as  sub-deacons,  aoolyths, 
readers,  &c.  The  three  proper  orders  were 
afterwards  distinguished  as  "  primi  clerici " 
(Cod.  Theod.  lib.  xiii.),  or  as  UpariKoi  (Cone. 
Laod.  cc.  24,  27,  &c. ;  Const.  Apostol.  c.  13 
seq.  50  seq.)  The  clergy  were  also  called 
"  canonici,"  from  the  word  "  Kavav "  which 
signifies,  in  this  connexion,  the  roll  or  list 
of  ecclesiastics  belonging  to  each  church 
(Cone.  Chalcedon,  c.  2;  Cone.  Nic.  c.  16), 
and  which  was  called  by  St.  Augustine  the 
"tabula  clericorum"  (Horn.  60).  The 
clergy  were,  after  the  introduction  of  monks, 
divided  into  regulars  and  seculars.  The 
regular  clergy  consist  of  those  monks,  or 
religious,  who  have  taken  upon  them  holy 
orders,  and  perform  the  offices  of  the  priest- 
hood in  their  respective  monasteries.  The 
secular  clergy  are  those  who  are  not  of  any 
religious  order,  and  have  the  care  and  direc- 
tion of  parishes.  In  1059  Pope  Nicolas 
established  a  new  rule  for  canonici,  which 
was  followed  by  a  stricter  rule  enjoined  by 
Ivo,  bishop  of  Chartres,  and  another  more 
generally  adopted,  drawn  up  by  Chrodegang, 
bishop  of  Metz.  Those  who  adopted  the 
former  were  called  Secular,  the  latter 
Regular  or  Augustinian  Canons.  (Bid. 
Christ.  Antiq.  397.  See  Monks.)  The 
canons  of  such  cathedrals  as  were  not 
monastic  foundations  were  called  secular 
canons.  But  cathedral  monasteries  are 
almost  peculiar  to  England.  (Stubbs' 
Introd.  to  Epp.  Cantuar.  xxi.) 

II.  The  privileges  and  immunities  which 
the  clergy  of  the  primitive  Christian  Church 
enjoyed,  deserve  our  notice.  In  the  first 
place,  whenever  they  travelled  upon  neces- 
sary occasions,  they  were  to  be  entertained 
by  their  brethren  of  the  clergy,  in  all  places, 
out  of  the  public  revenues  of  the  Church. 
When  any  bishop  or  presbyter  came  to  a 
foreign  Church,  they  were  to  be  compli- 
mented with  the  honorary  privilege  of  per- 
forming divine  ofiices,  and  consecrating  the 
Eucharist  in  the  church.  If  any  controver- 
sies happened  among  the  clergy,  they  freely 


CLERGY 

consented  to  have  tnem  determined  by  their 
bishops  and  councils,  without  having  re- 
course to  the  secular  magistrate  for  justice. 
The  great  care  the  clergy  had  of  the  charac- 
ters and  reputations  of  those  of  their  order 
appears  from  hence,  that,  in  all  accusations, 
especially  against  bishops,  they  required  the 
testimony  of  two  or  three  witnesses,  accord- 
ing to  the  Apostles'  rule ;  they  likewise 
examined  the  character  of  the  witnesses, 
before  their  testimony  was  admitted;  nor 
would  they  suffer  a  heretic  to  give  evidence 
against  a  clergjTuan.  These  instances  relate 
to  the  respect  which  the  clergy  mutually 
paid  to  each  other. 

With  regard  to  the  respect  paid  to  the 
clergy  by  the  civil  government,  it  consisted 
chiefly  in  exempting  them  from  some  kind 
of  obligations,  to  which  others  were  liable, 
and  in  granting  them  certain  privileges 
and  immunities  which  others  did  not  enjoy. 
Thus,  by  a  law  of  Justinian,  no  secular 
judge  could  compel  a  bishop  to  appear  in  a 
public  court,  to  give  his  testimony,  but  was 
to  send  one  of  his  officers  to  take  it  from 
his  mouth  in  private ;  nor  was  a  bishop 
obliged  to  give  his  t-estimony  upon  oath,  but 
only  upon  his  bare  word.  Presbyters,  we 
find,  were  privileged  from  being  questioned 
by  torture,  as  other  witnesses  were.  But  a 
still  more  extensive  privilege  was,  the 
exemption  of  the  clergy  fi-om  the  ordinary 
cognizance  of  the  secular  courts  in  all  causes 
purely  ecclesiastical ;  such  being  reserved 
for  the  hearing  of  the  bishops  and  councils, 
not  only  by  the  canons  of  the  Church,  but 
by  the  laws  of  the  State  also ;  as  appears 
from  several  rescripts  of  the  emperors  Con- 
stantius,  Valentinian,  Gratian,  Theodosius 
the  Great,  Arcadius  and  Honorius,  Va- 
lentinian II.,  and  Justinian. 

Another  privilege,  which  the  clergy  en- 
joyed by  the  favour  of  Christian  princes, 
was,  that,  in  certain  cases,  they  were  ex- 
empt from  some  of  the  taxes  laid  upon  the 
rest  of  the  Eoman  empire.  In  the  first 
place,  they  were  exempt  from  the  census 
capitum,  or  personal  tribute,  but  not  from 
the  census  agrorum,  or  tribute  arising  from 
men's  lands  and  possessions.  In  the  next 
place,  they  were  not  obliged  to  pay  the 
aurum  tironicum,  soldiers'  money,  nor,  the 
equwum  canonicorum  adseratio,  horse  mo- 
ney; which  were  taxes  laid  on  some  pro- 
vinces, for  famishing  the  emperor  with  new 
levies,  and  fresh  horses,  for  the  wars.  A 
third  tax  from  which  the  clergy  was  exempt 
was  thexpwcapyi'po'ithe  silver  and  gold  tax, 
which  was  laid  upon  trade  and  commerce ; 
'  and  the  fourth,  the  metatum,  so  called  from 
the  word  metatores,  which  signifies  the 
emperor's  forerunners  or  harbingers;  being 
a  duty  incumbent  on  the  subjects  of  the 
ernpire  to  give  entertainment  to.  the  emperor's 


CLEEGY 


205 


court  and  retinue,  when  they  travelled. 
The  clergy  were  also  exempt  from  contribut- 
ing to  the  reparation  of  highways  and  bridges, 
and  from  the  duties  called  angaria  and 
parangarise,  &c.,  by  which  the  subjects 
were  obliged  to  furnish  horses  and  carriages 
for  the  conveying  of  corn  for  the  use  of  the 
army. 

Another  sort  of  immunity  which  the 
clergy  enjoyed,  was  their  exemption  from 
civil  offices  in  the  Eoman  empire.  But  this 
privilege  was  confined  to  such  of  the  clergy 
as  had  no  estates,  but  what  belonged  to  the 
Church  by  the  laws  of  Constantine.  For 
the  Christian  princes  always  made  a  wide 
difference  between  the  public  patrimony  of 
the  Church,  and  the  private  estates  of  such 
of  the  clergy  as  had  lands  of  a  civil  or  secular 
tenure.  For  the  one,  the  clergy  were 
obliged  to  no  duty  or  burden  of  civil  offices ; 
but  for  the  other,  they  were,  and  could  not 
be  excused  from  them  otherwise  than  by 
providing  proper  substitutes  to  officiate  for 
them. 

III.  We  consider  next  the  principal  laws 
made  for  the  regulation  of  the  lives  and 
conversations  of  the  Christian  clergy. 

And,  first,  we  may  observe  what  sort  of 
crimes  were  thought  worthy  of  degradation. 
It  was  not  every  slight  failing  or  infirmity, 
for  which  a  clergyman  was  degraded,  but 
only  crimes  of  a  deeper  dye,  such  as  theft, 
murder,  fraud,  perjury,  sacrilege,  and  adul- 
teiy  :  to  which  may  be  added,  drinking  and 
gaming,  as,  also,  the  taking  of  money  upon 
usury,  which  is  condemned  by  many  of  the 
ancient  canons  as  a  species  of  covetousness 
and  cruelty.  The  clergy,  on  the  contrary, 
were  to  be  exemplary  for  hospitality  and 
charity  to  the  poor,  frugality,  and  a  contempt 
of  the  world.  And,  to  guard  against  de- 
famation and  scandal,  it  was  enacted  by  the 
canons  of  several  councils,  that  no  bishops, 
presbyters,  or  deacons  should  visit  widows 
and  virgins  alone,  but  in  the  company  and 
presence  of  some  other  of  the  clergy,  or 
some  grave  Christians. 

With  regard  to  the  laws,  more  particu- 
larly relating  to  the  exercise  of  the  duties 
and  offices  of  their  function,  the  clergy  were, 
in  the  first-  place,  obliged  to  lead  studious 
lives.  But  it  was  not  all  sorts  of  studies 
that  were  equally  recommended  to  them. 
The  principal  was  the  study  of  the  Holy 
Scriptures :  next  to  the  Scriptures,  they  were 
to  study  the  canons  of  the  Church,  and  the 
best  ecclesiastical  authors.  In  after  ages,  in 
the  time  of  Charles  the  Great,  we  find  some 
laws  obliging  the  clergy  to  read,  together 
with  the  canons,  Gregory's  book  De  Cura 
Pastorali.  As  to  other  books,  they  were 
more  cautious  and  sparing  in  the  study  and 
use  of  them.  Some  canons  forbad  a  bishop 
.to  read  heathen  authors ;  nor  was  he  allowed 


206 


CLERGY 


to  read  heretical  'books,  except  when  there 
was  occasion  to  confute  them,  or  to  caution 
others  against  the  poison  of  them.  But  the 
prohihition  of  heathen  learning  was  to  he 
understood  with  a  little  qualification.  It 
was  only  forbidden  so  far  as  it  tended  to  the 
neglect  of  Scripture  and  more  useful  studies. 
We  pass  over  the  obligations  incumbent  on 
them  to  attend  the  daily  service  of  the 
Church,  to  be  pious  and  devout  in  their 
public  addresses  to  God,  to  be  zealous  in 
defending  the  tmth,  and  maintaining  the 
unity  of  the  Church,  &c. 

By  the  ecclesiastical  laws,  no  clergyman 
was  allowed  to  relinquish  or  desert  his 
station  without  just  grounds  and  leave  :  yet, 
sometimes  resignation  was  allowed — such 
as  in  the  case  of  old  age,  sickness,  or  other 
infirmity.  No  clergyman  was  to  remove 
from  one  diocese  to  another,  without  the 
consent,  and  letters  dimissory,  of  his  own 
bishop.  The  laws  were  no  less  severe 
against  all  wandering  clergymen,  or  such 
as,  having  deserted  their  own  church,  would 
fix  in  no  other,  but  went  roving  from  place 
to  place  :  these  some  of  the  ancients  called 
fiaKavTifioi  or  Vacantivi.  By  the  laws  of  the 
Church,  the  bishops  were  not  to  permit  such 
to  officiate  in  their  dioceses,  nor  indeed  so 
much  as  to  communicate  in  their  churches. 
Other  laws  there  were,  which  obliged  the 
clergy  to  residence,  or  a  constant  attendance 
upon  their  duty.  The  Council  of  Sardica 
has  several  canons  relating  to  this  matter. 
Others  inhibited  pluralities,  or  the  officiating 
in  two  parochial  churches.  In  pursuance  of 
the  same  design,  of  keeping  the  clergy  strict 
and  constant  to  their  duty,  laws  were  also 
made  to  prohibit  them  following  any  secular 
employment,  which  might  divert  them  too 
much  from  their  proper  business  and  calling. 
In  some  times  and  places,  the  laws  of  the 
Church  were  so  strict  about  this  matter, 
that  they  would  not  suffer .  a  bishop,  or 
presbyter,  to  be  left  trustee  to  any  man's 
will.  By  other  laws  they  were  prohibited 
from  taking  upon  them  the  office  of  pleading 
at  the  bar  in  any  civil  contest. 

Another  sort  of  laws  respected  the  out- 
ward behaviour  of  the  clergy.  Such  were 
the  laws  against  corresponding  and  con- 
versing too  freely  with  Jews,  and  Gentile 
philosophers;  and  the  canons  which  re- 
strained them  from  eating  and  drinking  in 
a  tavern,  or  being  present  at  the  public 
theatres.  To  this  sort  of  laws  we  may 
reduce  the  ancient  rules  which  concern  the 
garb  and  habit  of  the  clergy  ;  which  were  to 
be  such  as  might  express  the  gravity  of 
their  minds,  without  any  affectation,  or 
superstitious  singularity.  As  to  the  kind 
or  fashion  of  their  apparel,  it  does  not 
appear,  for  several  ages,  that  there  was  any 
other  distinction  observed  therein  between 


CLERGY 

them  and  the  laity,  than  the  modesty  and 
gravity  of  their  garb,  without  being  tied  to 
any  certam  habit,  or  form  of  dress. — Bing- 
ham, bk.  i.  2,  V.  3,  vi.  2,  &c. 

These  were  the  principal  laws  and  regu- 
lations by  which  the  clergy  of  the  primi- 
tive Christian  Church  were  governed  ;  and 
it  is  remarkable,  that  the  apostate  emperor 
Julian  was  so  convinced  of  their  excellency, 
that  he  had  a  design  of  reforming  the 
heathen  priesthood  upon  the  model  of  the 
Christian  clergy. 

IV.  In  134:S,  by  Archbishop  Stratford's 
Constitution,  the  apparel  of  the  clergy 
was  defined,  and  the  74th  canon  of  1603 
enters  into  details  with  regard  to  dress, 
but,  as  Burn  observes,  "it  is  impossi- 
ble to  lay  down  rules  for  apparel  in  one 
age  which  will  not  appear  ridiculous  in 
the  next."  Canon  75  refers  to  the  moral 
behaviour  of  the  clergy,  and  forbids  their 
joining  in  unlawful  sports.  This,  however, 
does  not  include  lawful  recreations  which 
are  "good  for  the  clergy"  (Coke,  2  Inst. 
309)  ;  and  although  by  the  canon  law  they  are 
prohibited,  yet  by  the  common  law  they  are 
permitted  to  "use  the  recreation  of  hunting." 
It  was  ever  held  that  a  person  who  had  been 
ordained  a  clergyman  could  not  resign  his 
trust  (see  Bingham,  xvii.  ii.  5 ;  Hooker,  v. 
Ixxvii.  3 ;  Jer.  Taylor,  Episc.  Assert,  s.  xii. 
xxxi.  3),  but  this  rule  no  longer  exists  in 
the  law  of  the  Church  of  England.  (See 
Abdication  of  Orders.')    [H.] 

CLERGY,  DISCIPLINE  OP.  It  is 
difficult  to  decide  how  much  to  put  under 
the  head  of  clergy,  seeing  that  all  church  law 
relates  to  the  clergy.  We  shall  confine  this 
article  to  their  privileges  and  liabilities,  leav- 
ing other  matters  to  other  articles  through- 
out the  book ;  and  especially  the  subject  of 
clerical  judicature  as  established  at  the  Re- 
formation should  be  noticed  here.  What- 
ever privileges  they,  or  the  Church  of  Rome 
on  their  behalf,  may  have  had  or  usurped 
before,  their  relations  to  the  State  were  so 
materially  altered  then,  that  we  shall  not 
attempt  the  impossible  problem  of  deciding 
what  they  were  before.  Some  of  the  Refor- 
mation Acts  did  not  profess  to  make  new 
laws,  but  only  to  declare  the  old  law  of  the 
realm ;  but  it  is  unnecessary  to  regard  that 
distinction  in  this  case.  The  first  important 
Act  of  that  kind  was  that  of  1533,  25  Hen. 
VIII.  c.  19,  "  for  the  submission  of  the 
clergy,"  founded  partly  on  "  The  submission 
of  the  clergy  "  themselves,  in  the  two  convo- 
cations, which  was  completed  16  May,  1532, 
whereby  they  promised  in  verio  sacerdotii 
not  to  attempt  to  make  any  more  canons 
without  the  royal  assent,  and  also  agreed 
that  all  the  existing  canons  (which  were 
by  no  means  definable  either  then  or  now) 
should    be  submitted   to   thirtj--two  royal 


CLERGY 

commissioners,  of  whom  half  were  to  be  lay 
«nd  half  clerical ;  but  that  was  never  done. 
■"  The  Act  for  the  Submission  of  the  Clergy  " 
enacted  the  same,  and  also  by  a  separate  set 
of  clauses,  with  which  the  convocations  had 
nothing  to  do,  that  the  final  court  of  appeal, 
to  i^hich  (by  the  previous  Act  of  2i  Hen. 
Vin.  c.  12)  all  ecclesiastical  causes  should 
go,  should  be  "Delegates"  appointed  from 
i;ime  to  time  for  each  suit  by  the  Crown  in 
(Chancery.     (See  Delegates.) 

The  Delegates  were  unlimited,  and  ap- 
pointed pro  hoc  vice  only  in  every  case, 
And  were  generally  some  common  law  judges 
and  "  civilians,"  i.e.  lawyers  of  the  ecclesias- 
tical courts,  and  some  bishops  with  them — 
never  bishops  alone :  nor  anparently  even  a 
majority.  By  the  Acts  2  &  3  W.  IV.  c.  9, 
and  3  &  4  W.  IV.  c.  4,  the  Delegates  were 
Teplaced  by,  or  (we  may  say)  practically 
limited  to,  the  Judicial  Committee  of  the 
Privy  Council,  in  which  alterations  have 
■feeen  made  by  several  later  Acts  of  1840, 
1873,  and  1876.     (See  Judicial  Committee.) 

All  the  four  Acts  of  Uniformity,  i.e.  of 
•2  &  3  Edw.  VI.  c.  1,  establishing  the  first 
Prayer  Book  :  of  5  &  6  Edw.  VI.  c.  1,  estab- 
lishing the  second  book:  of  1  Eliz.  c.  2, 
making  a  few  slight  alterations  in  Edward's 
•second  book  :  and  of  13  &  14  Car.  11.  (the 
first  year  of  the  Restoration),  establishing 
the  present  Prayer  Book,  have  contained  or 
retained  an  enactment  that  clergymen  may 
"be  indicted  at  the  assizes,  where  the  bishop 
may  sit  with  the  judge,  for  wilfully  using 
any  but  the  authorised  prayers  or  cere- 
monies, or  preaching  or  speaking  in  de- 
Togation  thereof.  And  for  the  first  ofTence 
they  shail  he  imprisoned  six  months,  and  a 
year  for  the  second  with  deprivation  of 
all  spiritual  promotions,  and  be  imprisoned 
for  life  for  the  third ;  saving  also  the  juris- 
diction of  the  ecclesiastical  courts.  But 
they  must  be  indicted  at  the  next  assizes 
after  the  offence.  The  first  Act  of  Uni- 
formity contains  an  imrepealed  proviso, 
s.  7,  "  that  it  shall  be  lawful  for  all  men" 
"(meaning  all  who  'may  lawfully  perform 
divine  service)  "  to  use  any  psalm  or  prayer 
taken  out  of  the  Bible,  at  any  due  time,  not 
letting  or  omitting  thereby  any  part "  of  the 
service  in  the  Prayer  Book.  The  notion  of 
some  amateur  lawyers  that  such  a  proviso 
authorised  laymen  to  perform  divine  service 
of  any  kind  in  churches  is — only  fit  for 
amateurs,  who  fancy  that  Acts  of  Parliament 
are  held  by  the  Courts  to  mean  anything 
that  their  words  can  be  twisted  into  saying. 
And  these,  after  all,  would  only  authorise 
reading  a  small  part  of  the  Bible  in  church, 
which  is  very  far  from  what  they  want. 

It  is  unnecessary  now  to  dwell  on  the 
Court  of  High  Commission,  which  was 
established  under  1  Eliz.  c.  1,  with  all  the 


CLEKGY 


207 


powers  of  the  ecclesiastical  courts,  beyond 
saying  that  it  was  abolished  by  16  Car.  I.  c. 
11,  and  illegally  revived  by  James  II.  until  his 
fall,  and  declared  to  be  illegal  by  1  W.  &  M. 
sess.  2,  c.  2.  No  material  alteration  was 
made  in  clerical  judicature  until  the  modem 
Acts  already  mentioned.  The  Clergy  Dis- 
cipline Act,  3  &  4  Vict.  c.  86,  practically 
abolished  all  criminal  jurisdiction  of  the 
diocesan  courts  over  the  clergy,  except  in 
one  matter  (see  Chancellors) ;  for  the  new 
episcopal  jurisdiction,  with  an  appeal  to  the 
provincial  court,  was  not  a  revival  of  the  old 
jurisdiction  of  the  diocesan  courts ;  but  a 
new  contrivance  (of  Bp.  Philpotts)  for  giving 
personal  jurisdiction  to  the  bishops  with 
only  the  advice  of  assessors.  Practically 
that  clause  might  as  well  not  be  in  the 
Act,  for  all  clerical  offences  are  sent  to  the 
provincial  court  by  letters  of  request  from 
the  bishop ;  and  it  has  been  held  that  the 
provincial  judge  must  accept  them.  A 
diocesan  chancellor  may  also  send  letters  of 
request,  but  not  in  criminal  cases,  as  that 
would  be  contrary  to  this  Act.  But  it  does 
not  appear  that  he  can  thereby  send  a  case 
which  he  ought  to  try  himself  to  the 
provincial  court  ex  Tnero  motu,  though  it  is 
said  that  he  may  at  the  plaintiff's  request 
(Phillimore,  Eccl.  Law).  A  bishop  cannot 
now  punish  any  offence  at  a  visitation,  but 
can  only  use  the  visitation  to  inquire  into 
it.  But  it  has  not  yet  been  decided  that 
he  could  not  "signify"  a  person  to  the 
Lord  Chancellor  for  contempt  at  a  visita- 
tion. The  Public  Worship  Regulation  Act, 
1874,  was  intended  to  remedy  some  of  the 
defects  of  the  Discipline  Act,  but  only  made 
them  worse,  partly  from  the  usual  modern 
faults,  of  being  overloaded  with  techni- 
calities, and  being  badly  drawn,  or  amended, 
chiefly  by  Lord  Cairns,  then  Chancellor; 
but  most  of  all  from  the  astonishing  folly  of 
leaving  the  suspension  of  a  clergyman  for 
disobedience  to  stand  for  three  years  before 
it  ripens  into  deprivation.  The  fusion  of 
the  offices  of  the  two  provincial  judges  was 
more  likely  to  secure  a  fiilly  competent  one ; 
but  requiring  the  approval  of  the  Prime  Min- 
ister to  an  appointment  by  both  archbishops 
was  a  needless  and  offensive  usurpation.  The 
chief  improvement  was  one  very  little  known, 
viz.  that  it  dispensed  with  the  cumbrous 
proceeding  by  articles,  but  unluckily  only  in 
prosecutions  under  that  Act  itself.  In  short, 
there  is  hardly  a  clause  in  it  which  has  not 
been  in  one  way  or  another  abortive, 
offensive,  or  objectionable,  and  it  has  pro- 
bably become  a  dead  letter  except  as  to  the 
provincial  judge's  appointment. 

Two  important  alterations  were  made  in 
1801  and  1870,  in  the  capacity  of  the  clergy 
for  undertaking  various  lay  functions.  Un- 
til 41  Geo.  III.  c.  63,  clergymen  could  and  did 


208 


CLERGY 


occasionally  sit  in  the  House  of  Commons, 
jind  they  do  still  in  the  Lords  if  they  happen 
to  be  peers.  But  in  1801  an  Act  was  passed, 
notoriously  to  incapacitate  the  Rev.  J.  Home 
Tooke,  who  had  sat  in  one  Parliament 
already  and  was  a  candidate  again;  which 
professed  to  remove  doubts  on  the  subject, 
and  enacted  that  no  person  ordained  a  priest 
or  deacon,  or  a  minister  of  the  (Presbyterian) 
Church  of  Scotland,  shall  sit  in  Parliament. 
About  the  same  time  all  the  Inns  of  Court 
resolved  that  no  such  person  should  be 
called  to  the  bar.  The  latter  prohibition 
was  rescinded  by  them  all,  about  1860,  for 
clergymen  who  hona  fide  give  up  clerical 
work ;  and  by  33  &  34  Vict.  c.  91  (repealing 
canon  76),  they  are  allowed  to  abdicate  by 
an  irrevocable  deed  registered,  and  can 
never  afterwards  perform  any  clerical  func- 
tions, and  so  they  become  laymen  for  all 
practical  purposes,  but  cannot  be  reordained. 
The  abdication  is  not  complete  or  irrevocable 
till  the  clergyman  registers  it.  Beneficed 
or  licensed  clergymen  may  not  trade  or 
hire  more  than  eighty  acres  to  farm,  by  1 
&  2  Vict.  c.  106,  without  a  bishop's  licence, 
nor  be  a  director  or  managing  partner 
of  any  trading  company  not  being  of  the 
nature  of  an  assurance  office ;  and  those  who 
do  are  to  be  suspended  byithe  chancellor, 
and  for  a  third  offence  deprived,  s.  31. 

Clergymen  are  exempt  from  serving  on 
juries,  in  municipal  corporations,  and  gene- 
rally from  all  offices  and  duties  that  are 
usually  performed  by  laymen.  Moreover, 
by  canoa  75,  they  are  prohibited  from 
resorting  to  taverns,  except  for  their  honest 
necessities,  and  from  boarding  or  lodging 
there,  and  from  playing  at  dice,  cards, 
tables,  or  other  unlawful  games.  They 
may  be  deprived  as  well  as  suspended  for 
gross  immorality  and  habitual  drunkeimess, 
the  degree  of  which  has  to  be  judged  by  the 
Court.  But  it  seema  that  drunkenness 
must  be  proved  to  be  very  habitual  indeed, 
to  be  published  by  deprivation,  according  to 
modern  practice,  the  inexpediency  of  which 
is  evident.  And  the  difficulty  of  getting 
witnesses  to  prove  it  is  notorious. 

There  is  another  most  important  Act  of 
13  Elizabeth,  c.  12,  "  For  ministers  to  be  of 
sound  religion."  It  is  shortly  this,  and  is 
in  every  way  a  model  for  modem  bill- 
drawers,  who  often  caimot  make  their  Acts 
to  work  for  three  years — while  this  has 
worked  for  more  than  three  centuries.  "  If 
any  ecclesiastical  person  shall  advisedly 
maintain  any  doctrine  repugnant  to  any  of 
the  thirty- nine  articles  of  religion,  and  shall 
persist  them,  or  not  revoke  his  error,  or 
repeat  it  afterwards,  it  shall  be  just  cause  to 
deprive  him  of  his  ecclesiastical  promotions." 
Many  privations  have  taken  place  there- 
under ;  and  the  revocation  to  avoid  it  must 


CLEEK 

bo  sim|)le  and  complete.  (Burder  v.  Heath, 
Ecc.  Judgments  in  P.  C.)  The  Acts  of 
Uniformity,  besides  the  temporal  penalties 
already  mentioned  for  "  depraving "  the 
Prayer  Book,  reserve  power  to  the  ecclesias- 
tical courts  to  punish  the  same  offences  by 
deprivation,  and  minor  censures  as  before. 
And  clergymen  punished  by  the  ecclesias- 
tical cotirts  shall  not  be  again  convicted. 
before  the  justices  ;  and  vice  versa.  It. 
seems  that  one  Fleming  was  convicted  and 
punished  in  26  Eliz.  for  baptising  in  a, 
different  form  from  that  prescribed  in  the 
Prayer  Book.  It  has  also  been  held  that 
the  power  of  the  ecclesiastical  court  to 
deprive  for  such  offences  was  not  then  first 
given,  but  was  only  reserved  as  of  old. 
What  are  now  called  ritual  offences  are  of 
this  kind,  being  transgressions  of  the  rubrics 
of  the  Prayer  Book.  The  theory  of  "a 
minimum  of  ceremonial  required,  and  a 
maximum  allowed,"  has  always  been  re- 
pudiated by  the  Privy  Council,  though  it 
found  favour  with  a  late  Dean  of  Arches. 
(See  Mitual,  Rvhrics,  Advertisements,  and 
ISimony ;  Curates'  Residence,  Divine  Service, 
Clerical  Subscription,  Plurality.')   [G-.] 

CLERICAL  SUBSCRIPTION.  This 
was  considerably  modified  by  the  Act  of 
1865,  28  &  29  Vict.  c.  122,  and  the  36tk 
canon  of  1603  was  accordingly  altered  by  the 
convocations  under  royal  licence  in  1865. 
The  only  assent  now  required  is  in  these 
words  :  "  I  assent  to  the  thirty-nine  articles 
of  religion,  and  to  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer,  and  ordering  of  bishops,  priests,  and 
deacons.  I  believe  the  doctrine  of  the 
Church  of  England  as  therein  set  forth  to 
be  agreeable  to  the  Word  of  God,  and  in 
public  prayer  and  administration  of  the 
Sacraments  I  will  use  the  form  in  the  said 
book  provided  and  no  other,  except  so  far 
as  may  be  allowed  by  lawful  authority." 
This  declaration  has  to  be  made  on  every 
ordination,  institution,  or  licence,  besides  the 
"  reading  in "  to  a  benefice,  or  reading  the 
articles  in  church  on  the  first  Sunday  he 
officiates,  or  on  some  other  by  leave  of  the 
bishop.  And  the  assent  is  to  follow  such 
reading.  Curates  do  not  read  the  articles, 
but  only  signify  their  assent  as  above.    [G.] 

CLERK.  The  word  is  in  fact  only  an 
abbreviation  of  the  word  clericus,  or  clergy- 
man, and  the  proper  designation  of  a  clergy- 
man is  "  clerk  in  Holy  Orders." 

But  it  is  also  used  to  designate  certaia 
laymen,  who  are  appointed  to  conduct  or 
lead  the  responses  of  the  congregation,  and 
otherwise  to  assist  in  the  services  of  the 
church.  Li  most  cathedrals  and  collegiate 
churches,  and  in  some  colleges,  there  are 
several  of  these  lay  clerks  (see  Vicar  Choral, 
Secondary,  and  Stipendiary);  who  were, 
originally,  real  clerks,  i.e.  clergymen,  gen- 


CLERK 

erally  in  niiiior  orders ,  who  assisted  the 
officiating  priest.  But  the  minor  orders  have 
long  ceased  to  be  conferred,  except  as  sym- 
bolical steps  towards  the  higher  grades  of 
the  ministry;  so  that  in  countries  of  the 
Eomish  communion  as  well  as  among  onr- 
selves,  the  office  which  used  to  be  performed 
by  one  or  more  clergymen  has  devolved  upon 
laymen.  There  were,  in  the  first  place, 
several  of  these  clei'lis  in  each  church  who 
used  to  siag  the  office  with  the  minister  in 
the  "quire";  but  in  later  times  the  service 
was  frequently  read  outside  the  quire,  at  a 
"reading  pue"  erected  for  the  purpose  in 
accordance  with  the  opinion  of  Bucer,  who 
held  it  "  anti-christian "  for  the  minister 
to  read  from  the  quire.  The  clerks,  then, 
were  reduced  to  one ;  the  authorised  mode 
of  divine  worship  was  altered  in  the 
generality  of  churches  in  the  seventeenth 
and  eighteenth  centuries ;  and  the  responses 
were  said  by  a  parish  clerk,  the  congregation 
hardly  joining  in  at  all.  This  is  contrary 
to  the  eighteenth  canon,  and  to  the  idea 
of  "clerks"  as  mentioned  in  the  rubrics. 
The  eighteenth  canon  directs  all  persons, 
man,  woman,  and  child,  to  say  in  their  due 
places,  audibly  with  the  minister,  the  Con- 
fession, the  Lord's  Prayer,  and  the  Creed, 
and  make  such  other  ansvpers  to  the  public 
prayer  as  are  appointed  in  the  Book  of 
Common  Prayer ;  and  the  laity  forfeit  a 
high  privilege  when  they  leave  their  share 
of  the  service  to  the  lay-clerk  alone. 

Clerics,  in  the  plural,  are  mentioned  in  the 
Prayer  Book  in  the  rubric  before  the  second 
occurrence  of  the  Lord's  Prayer,  in  Morn- 
ing and  Evening  Prayer :  "  The  minister, 
clerks,  and  people  shall  say  the  Lord's 
Prayer  with  a  loud  voice ; "  in  the  Marriage 
Service,  "  The  minister  and  clerks,  going  to 
the  Lord's  table,  shall  say  or  sing  this 
Psalm  following;"  in  the  Burial  Service, 
"  The  priest  and  clerks  meeting  the  corpse 
at  the  entrance  of  the  churchyard,  &c., 
shall  say  or  sing  ; "  and  when  they  are  come 
to  the  grave, "  The  priest  shall  say,  or  the 
priest  and  clerks  shall  sing;"  and  iu  the 
Commination  Service,  "  The  priest  and 
clerks,  kneeling  (in  the  place  where  they 
are  accustomed  to  say  the  Litany),  shall 
say  this  Psalm,  Miserere  mei,  BewsP  The 
cUrh  in  the  singular  number  is  mentioned 
but  once  only,  which  is  in  tbe  Marriage 
Service ;  where  the  man  is  directed  to  lay 
the  ring  on  the  book  "  with  the  accustomed 
duty  to  the  priest  and  derk"  The  parish 
derk  originally  was  the  aqusehajalus,  or 
holy  water  carrier,  an  office  anciently  con- 
feiTed  upon  poor  clergy  (Boniface,  iznd.142). 

According  to  canon  91,  parish  clerks  are 
to  be  chosen  by  the  minister,  who  shall  sig- 
nify his  choice  to  the  parishioners,  in  the  time 
of  divine  service. 


CLOISTER 


209 


Since  the  making  of  this  canon,  the 
right  of  putting  in  the  parish  clerk  has 
often  been  contested  between  incumbents 
and  parishioners,  and  prohibitions  prayed, 
and  always  obtained,  to  the  spiritual  court, 
for  maintaining  the  authority  of  the  canon 
in  favour  of  the  incumbent,  against  the  plea 
of  custom  in  behalf  of  the  parishioners. 

All  the  incumbents  once  had  the  right  of 
nomination  of  the  parish  clerks,  by  the 
common  law  and  custom  of  the  realm. 

Parish  clerks,  after  having  been  duly 
chosen  and  appointed,  are  usually  licensed 
by  the  ordinary.  And  when  they  are  li- 
censed, they  are  sworn  to  obey  the  minister. 

By  a  recent  regulation  (7  &  8  Vict.  c. 
59)  persons  in  holy  orders  may  be  appointed 
to  the  office  of  parish  clerk,  which  is  to  be 
held  under  the  same  tenure  as  that  of  a 
stipendiary  curacy.  Lay  parish-clerks  may 
also  be  dismissed  by  the  archdeacon  on 
complaint,  but  he  must  hear  them  first. 

By  7  &  8  Wm.  in.  c.  35,  a  parish  clerk, 
for  assisting  at  a  marriage,  without  banns 
or  licence,  shall  forfeit  five  pounds  for  every 
such  offence. 

CLINIC  BAPTISM.  Baptism  on  a  sick 
bed  (kXi'vt;)  was  so  called  in  the  primitive 
Church.  In  the  earlier  ages  of  Christianity 
certain  solemn  days  were  set  apart  for  the 
administration  of  holy  baptism,  and  only 
on  extraordinary  occasions  were  converts 
baptized,  except  on  one  or  other  of  those 
days;  but  if  one  already  a  candidate  for 
baptism  fell  sick,  and  if  his  life  was  en- 
dangered, he  was  allowed  to  receive  clinic 
baptism.  And  this  not  by  immersion,  but 
by  affusion  (see  letter  of  St.  Cyprian  to 
Magnus,  circ.  a.d.  265,  Ep.  Ixix.  11,  12). 
But  aliuses  crept  in  with  regard  to 
clinic  baptism  ;  some  persons  who  were 
converts  to  the  doctrines  of  Christianity 
would  not  be  baptized  while  in  health 
and  vigour,  because  of  the  greater 
holiness  of  life  to  which  they  would  ac- 
count themselves  pledged,  and  because  they 
thought  that  baptism  administered  on  their 
death-bed  would  wash  away  the  sins  of 
their  life.  Such  persons,  though  they  re- 
covered after  their  baptism,  were  held  to 
be  under  several  disabilities,  and  especially 
they  were  not  admitted  as  candidates  for 
holy  orders. 

CLOISTER.  (See  Monastery.)  A 
covered  walk,  generally  occupying  the  four 
sides  of  a  quadrangle,  which  is  almost 
an  invariable  appendage  to  a  monastic  or 
ancient  collegiate  residence.  The  most 
beautiful  cloister  remaining  in  England  is 
at  Gloucester  cathedral.  Many  of  the 
cathedrals  have  or  had  cloisters;  as  old  St. 
Paul's,  Chichester,  Exeter,  Hereford,  Lincoln, 
Salisbury,  Wells,  Worcester,  Durham,  Nor- 
wich,  Peterborough,   Chester,   Oxford,   St. 

p 


,210 


CLOVESHO 


Alban's,  and  formerly  St.  Patrick's  in  Dub- 
lin :  and  some  colleges,  as  New  College' 
Magdalen,  and  Corpus  at  Oxford  ;  Trinity, 
Jesus,  Queen's,  at  Cambridge ;  Wincbester 
and  Eton.  A  cloister  was  projected  for 
King's  College  by  the  founder,  but  never 
built.  St.  (Jeorge's  Chapel  at  Windsor  has 
fl.lso  fL  ploistcr 

CLOVESHO,  Councils  of.  The  exact 
locality  of  these  is  not  known,  except  that  it 
■was  in  Mercia,  probably  near  London.  There 
■were  five  of  these  councils,  the  first  being 
held  in  716  for  confinning  certain  privileges 
to  the  churches  of  Kent,  by  a  synod  of 
bishops.  The  chief  was  the  third  (747), 
when  an  attempt  was  made  to  enforce  the 
Eoman  Liturgy  on  all  the  dioceses  of  the 
country,  which  "was  quickly  evaded." — 
Haddan  and  Stubbs'  Counc. ;  Hook's  Arch- 
iishops,  vol.  i.  224,  seq.)     [H.] 

CLUNIAC  MONKS.  "  Eeligious  "  of  the 
order  of  Cluny.  It  was  the  first  reformed 
branch  of  the  order  of  St.  Benedict. 

I.  Berno,  abbot  of  Gigni,  of  the  family 
of  the  earls  of  Burgundy,  was  the  founder 
of  this  order.  In  the  year  912,  at  the 
invitation  of  William,  Duke  of  Auvergne, 
he  built  a  monastery  for  the  reception  of 
Benedictine  monks,  in  the  town  of  Cluny,  or 
Clugny,  in  Prance,  situated  in  the  Ma- 
■connois,  11  miles  N.W.  of  Macon  on  the 
river  Grone.  The  noble  abbey  of  Cluny  was 
destroyed  in  1789. 

The  monks  of  Cluny  were  remark- 
able for  their  sanctity.  They  every  day 
sang  two  solemn  masses.  They  so  strictly 
observed  silence,  that  "  they  would  rather 
have  died  than  break  it  before  the  hour 
of  prime."  When  they  were  at  work, 
they  recited  psalms.  'They  fed  eighteen 
poor  persons  every  day,  and  were  so  pro- 
fuse of  their  charity  in  Lent,  that  one  year, 
at  the  beginning  of  Lent,  they  distributed 
salt  meat,  and  other  alms,  among  7000  poor. 

The  preparation  they  used  for  making 
the  bread  v;hich  was  to  serve  for  the  Eu- 
charist is  worthy  to  be  observed.  They  first 
chose  the  wheat  grain  by  grain,  and  washed 
it  very  carefully.  Then  a  servant  carried  it 
in  a  bag  to  the  mill,  and  washed  the  grind- 
stones, and  covered  them  with  curtains. 
The  meal  was  afterwards  washed  In  clean 
water,  and  baked  in  iron  moulds. 

The  extraordinary  discipline  observed  in 
the  monasteries  of  Cluny  soon  spread  its 
fame  in  all  parts.  France,  Germany,  Eng- 
land, Spain,  and  Italy,  desired  to  have  some 
of  these  "  religious,"  for  whom  they  built  new 
monasteries.  They  also  passed  into  the 
East ;  and  there  was  scarcely  a  place  in 
Europe  where  the  order  was  not  known. 
By  the  end  of  the  twelfth  century  the 
number  of  Cluniac  houses  amounted  to  2000. 
The  principal  monasteries  in  which  the  dis- 


COADJUTOP. 

ci  pline  and  rules  of  Cluny  were  observed,  were 
those  of  Tulles,  in  the  Limousin,  AurlUac 
in  Auvergne,  Bourgdieuand  Massa  in  Berri, 
St.  Benet  on  the  Loire  in  the  Orleanois,  St. 
Peter  le  Vif  at  Sens,  St.  Allire  of  Clermont, 
St.  Julian  of  Tours,  Sarlat  in  Perigord, 
and  Eoman-Mourier  in  the  country  of  Vaux. 

This  order  was  divided  into  ten  provinces, 
being  those  of  Dauphine,  Auvergne,  Poitiers, 
Saintonge,  and  Grascony,  in  France ;  Spain, 
Italy,  Lombardy,  Germany,  and  England. 

At  the  general  chapters,  which  were  at 
first  held  yearly,  and  afterwards  every  three 
years,  two  visitors  were  chosen  for  every 
province,  and  two  others  for  the  monasteries 
6f  nuns  of  this  order,  fifteen  definitors,  three 
auditors  of  causes,  and  two  auditors  of  ex- 
cuses. There  were  formerly  five  principal 
priories,  called  the  first  five  daughters  of 
Cluny ;  but,  after  the  dissolution  of  the 
monasteries  in  England,  which  involved 
that  of  St.  Pancras,  at  Lewes  in  Sussex, 
there  remained  but  four  principal  priories, 
being  those  of  La  Charite  sur  Loire,  St. 
Martin  des  Champs  at  Paris,  Souvigni,  and 
Souxillanges. 

II.  The  Cluniac  monks  were  first  brought 
into  England  by  William,  Earl  of  Warren, 
in  the  year  of  our  Lord  1077,  to  occupy  the 
priory  founded  by  him  and  his  wife 
Gundrada  at  Lewes.  These  "  religious," 
though  they  lived  imder  the  rule  of  St. 
Benedict,  and  wore  a  black  habit,  yet, 
because  their  discipline  and  observances 
differed  in  many  things  from  those  of  the 
Benedictines,  were  not  called  Benedictines, 
but  monks  of  the  order  of  Clrmy.  In 
the  reign  of  Henry  V.,  the  Cluniac  monas- 
teries, by  reason  of  the  war  between  England 
and  France,  were  cut  ofi:  from  the  obedience 
of  the  abbot  of  Cluny,  nor  were  they 
permitted  to  have  any  intercourse  with  the 
monasteries  of  then-  order  out  of  England. 
The  monasteries  of  Cluniac  monks  in 
England  amounted  in  number  to  tliirty- 
eight. — ^Broughton's  Bibliotlieca  liistorico- 
Sacra. ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  601 :  ii.  43 ; 
Robertson,  Hist,  of  Ch.  ii.  part  ii.  p.  521-4. 

COADJUTOR.  When  a  bishop  became 
very  aged,  or  was  otherwise  incapacitated 
from  fulfilling  the  duties  of  his  office,  a 
coadjutor  was  allowed  to  him.  The  ancient , 
rule,  indeed,  confirmed  by  the  Nicene  canon, 
was  that  there  should  not  be  more  than  one 
bishop  in  a  city ;  but  exceptions  were  made 
in  such  cases.  Thus  Alexander  was  made 
coadjutor  to  Narcissus,  bishop  of  Jerusalem, 
who  was  120  years  old  (Euseb.  lib.  vi.  c.  11) ; 
and  many  other  instances  are  given  by  the 
early  historians  (Soz.  vi.  8 ;  Socrat.  iv. 
26,  &o.).  There  was  often  a  question  as 
to  whether  the  coadjutor  should  succeed, 
and  it  was  generally  allowed  at  first,  as  in 
the  case  of  St.  Augustine  at  Hippo,  who. 


CODICES 

howevei-,  seems  to  have  been  himself 
doubtful  ou  the  matter,  and  would  not 
ordain  Eradius  bishop  while  he  himself 
lived,  for,  he  said,  "  quod  reprehensum  est 
in  me,  nolo  reprehendi  in  filio  meo  "  (Aug. 
Ep.  110;  see  also  Ep.  31,  and  Possid.  Vit. 
Aug.  48).  Afterwards  no  right  of  succession 
was  allowed  (St.  Greg.  M.  Epist.  ix.  41). 
In  England  the  coadjutor  to  a  bishop  was 
often  appointed  to  look  after  the  temporali- 
ties only,  and  as  such  need  not  be  a  bishop, 
the  spiritual  part  being  committed  by  the 
metropolitan  to  a  suffragan  bishop  (see 
Suffragans) ;  and  for  archdeacons,  digni- 
Xaries,  or  parochial  ministers  coadjutors  could 
be  appointed ;  and  in  the  time  of  Archbishop 
Abbot,  and  of  Archbishop  Sancroft,  we  find 
•the  commission  explained  by  orders  to  be 
observed  "  between  the  minister  and  his 
•coadjutor  in  point  of  profits,"  &c. — Gribs. 
137,  901,  902 ;  Bingham,  bk.  ii.  c.  xiii. ; 
Did.  Christ.  Ant.  398. 

Coadjutor  bishops  can  be  appointed  now 
;under  the  "  Bishops'  Resignation  Act,  1869," 
who  have  the  right  to  succeed.  But  not 
one  has  been  made  yet,  the  bishops  having 
all  preferred  to  resign  completely. 
.  CODICES  CANONUM.  Of  these  the 
chief  are — the  code  of  the  Roman,  and  the 
-code  of  the  Greek  Church.  The  former  was 
■compiled  by  Dionysius  Exiguus,  from  two 
previous  collections,  and  showed  157  canons ; 
the  latter  was  compiled  by  John  Scholas- 
ticus  (who  became  patriarch  of  Constanti- 
nople in  the  last  year  of  Justinian),  and 
displayed  224  canons  exclusive  of  68  of  St. 
3asil.— Migne's  Patrol.  Ixvii.  135,  139; 
Ivi.  18,  206,  747,  816,  &c. 

COENOBITES.  Monks,  who  lived  to- 
gether in  a  fix;ed  habitation,  and  formed  one 
large  community  under  a  chief,  whom  they 
•called  father  or  abbot.  The  word  is  derived 
from  Koivofitov,  vitse  communis  sociefas. 
(See  Monks.)  The  ancients  discriminated 
between  a  ccenobium  and  a  monastery. 
The  latter  was  properly  the  dwelling  of  a 
solitary  monk  or  hermit ;  the  former,  of 
associated  monks  who  lived  together  in  a 
society.  The  institution  of  Coenobites  was, 
.according  tn  Cassian,  to  be  traced  to  the 
faithful  at  Jerusalem  who,  in  the  Apostles' 
time,  "had  all  things  common."  (Cass. 
Collat.  xviiL  c.  5.)  But  as  an  order,  the 
founder  was  Pachomius,  who  lived  fifty 
years  before  Cassian's  yisit  to  Egypt,  and 
who  planted  several  establishments  on  the 
tenks  of  the  Nile.  Before  his  death  in  348, 
the  Ccenobites  numbered  over  7000  persons. 
The  monks  under  Pachomius's  rule  lived  in 
■dwellings,  grouped  together  yet  detached, 
«ach  house  containing  three  monks.  These 
•clusters  were  called  Laurie.  (See  Laura.) 
•Basil  the  Great  seems  to  have  been  the  first 
to  build  houses  in  which  all  lived  together. — 


COLLECTS 


211 


Newman's  Fleury,  xx.  5 ;  Robertson,  Hist, 
of  Oh.  i.  266, 328-330 ;  Bingham,  Ant.  vii.  2  ; 
Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  336. 

CCENA  DOMINI.  The  supper  of  our 
Lord.  This  title  was  given  in  early  times 
to  the  fifth  day  in  Holy  Week.  (See 
Maundy-  TImrsday. ) 

CGENA  DOMINL  (See  Bull  in  Ciena 
Domini.) 

COFFIN,  literally  a  basket ;  Gk.  ko(J}Ivos  ; 
Pr.  "coffre";  Norm.  Pr.  "cofin";  Sp. 
"  cofin  " ;  Welsh  "  cofawr,"  from  cof,  a  hoUow 
trunk.  The  word  was  used  for  a  shrine  or  box 
(Wyntosvn's  Chronylcil),  but  it  now  gener- 
ally denotes  the  box  of  wood  or  of  lead  in 
which  a  dead  body  is  placed  for  burial.  From 
the  seventh  to  the  twelfth  century  coffins 
were  generally  of  stone,  when  used  at  all ; 
but  for  common  people  they  were  not  used. 

COLLATION.  The  term  used  when  a 
bishop  gives  a  benefice,  which  either  he  had 
as  patron,  or  which  came  to  him  by  lapse. 

It  is  also  used  by  ecclesiastical  writers  to 
denote  the  spare  meal  on  days  of  abstinence, 
consisting  of  bread  or  other  fruits,  but 
without  meat ;  sometimes  also  the  reading 
from  the  lives  or  collations  of  the  fathers  in 
a  monastery  before  compline. 

COLLECTS.  I.  The  meaning  of  the 
term.  II.  Tlie  construction.  III.  Tlie 
sources.  I.  Collects  are  certain  brief  and  com- 
prehensive prayers,  which  are  found  in  all 
known  liturgies  and  public  devotional  offices 
of  the  Western  Church.  Ritualists  have 
thought  that  these  prayers  were  so  called 
because  they  were  used  in  the  public  congre- 
gation or  collection  of  the  people  ;  or  from  the 
fact  of  many  petitions  being  here  collected 
together  in  a  brief  summary;  or  because  they 
comprehend  objects  of  prayer  collected  out 
of  the  Epistles  and  Gospels.  But  whatever 
may  be  the  origin  of  the  tenn,  it  is  one  of 
great  antiquity.  It  is  indeed  difiicult  to 
trace  the  antiquity  of  repeating  collects  at 
the  end  of  the  service.  It  certainly,  however, 
prevailed  in  our  own  Church,  the  Church  of 
England,  even  during  the  period  preceding 
the  Norman  Conquest.  The  very  collects 
that  we  still  use,  formed  part  of  the 
devotional  oSices  of  our  Church  long  before 
the  Reformation. 

The  move  usual  name  in  the  Latin  Church 
was  orationes  collectx,  because  the  prayers 
of  the  bishop  or  priest,  which  in  any  part  of 
the  service  followed  the  joint  prayers  of  the 
deacon  and  congregation,  were  both  a  recol- 
lection and  recommendation  of  the  prayers 
of  the  people.  In  this  sense  Cassian  takes 
the  phrase,  colligere  orationem.  When 
speaking  of  the  service  in  the  Egyptian 
monasteries  and  Eastern  churches,  he  says, 
"  after  the  psalms  they  had  private  prayers, 
which  they  said  partly  standing  and  partly 
kneeling :     which    being    ended,    he    that 

p  2 


212 


COLLECTS 


collected  the  prayer  rose  up,  and  then  tliey 
all  rose  up  together  with  him,  none  presum- 
ing to  continue  longer  upon  the  ground,  lest 
he  should  seem  rather  to  pursue  his  own 
prayers  than  go  along  with  him  who  collected 
the  prayers,  or  closed  up  all  with  his  con- 
cluding collect."  (Institutes,  ii.  9).  Where 
we  may  observe,  that  a  collect  is  taken  for 
the  chief  ministei-'s  prayer  at  the  close  of 
some  part  of  divine  service,  collecting  and 
concluding  the  people's  preceding  devotions. 
Uranius,  speaking  of  one  John,  bishop  of 
Naples,  who  died  in  the  celebration  of 
divine  service,  says,  "  he  gave  the  signal  to 
the  people  to  pray,  and  then,  having  summed 
up  their  prayers  in  a  collect,  he  yielded  up 
the  ghost." — Bingham,  bk.  xv.  c.  1,  seq. 

Walpidius  Strabo  (_De  Eeh.  Eccl.  c.  22), 
as  quoted  by  Wheatly,  says  that  they  are 
so  called  because  the  priest  collects  the  pe- 
titions of  all  in  a  compendious  brevity. 
Archbishop  Trench  gives  as  his  opinion  that 
they  have  their  name  because  they  collect,  as 
into  a  focus,  the  teaching  of  the  Epistle  and 
Gospel,  gathering  them  up  into  a  single 
petition.  (See  also  Freeman's  Principles  of 
Divine  Worship,!.  146,  212,  3(57.)  Tliey 
are  in  fact  used  in  contradistinction  to  the 
alternate  versicles,  and  the  larger  and  less 
compendious  prayers.  (Bona,  jRer.  Liturg. 
ii.  5 ;  Micrologus,  iii.) 

Morinus,  in  his  notes  on  Greek  Ordination, 
remarks  on  the  resemblance  between  the 
Greek  word  o-wi/ottttj,  and  the  Latin  collecta: 
but  shows  that  the  cruvaTrrTj,  though  meaning 
a  connected  prayer,  has  a  very  different  use. 
The  trovaTiT^  was  sometimes  a  sort  of  litany, 
sometimes  a  set  of  versicles  resembling  the 
"preces"  of  the  Eoman  Church,  or  our 
versicles  and  responses  after  the  Creed.  The 
<rvvafVTr]  fieyaXj]  a^ain,  is  like  our  Prayer 
for  the  Church  Militant.  The  Greek  tix"? 
said  after  the  truvmrTri  is  more  like  our  collect : 
but  there  is  nothing  exactly  resembling  it 
in  the  Greek  formularies.  Their  prayers 
are  generally  much  longer. 

II.  The  collects  are  for  the  most  part 
constructed  upon  one  uniform  rule,  subject 
to  a  threefold  division,  which  has  thus  been 
stated : 

1.  Introduction. — Invocation  of  God's 
Name:  often,  but  not  always,  including  a 
commemoration  of  one  of  His  attributes,  or 
of  one  of  His  actions.  2.  Main  part. — 
Petition  for  some  boon,  often,  but  not  always, 
accompanied  by  a  statement  of  the  good 
to  he  expected  from  such  boon.  3.  Con- 
clusion.— Glory  given  to  God,  or  afiHance 
in  Christ,  or  both  together.  (Freeman's 
Principles  of  Divine  Service,  i.  372.) 

As  a  general  rule  a  collect  is  addressed  to 
God  the  Father,  as  it  is  the, supplication  of 
many  gathered  into  one  by  the  voice  of  the 
minister,  and  offered  by  him  to  the  Father, 


COLLECTS 

through  our  only  Mediator.  Tlie  eucharistic 
worship,  too,  has  regard  to  the  sacrifice 
offered  to  the  Father  by  the  Son.  (Bona,  i. 
3,  ii.)  Three  collects  in  our  Prayer  Book 
address  the  Son,  namely,  those  for  St. 
Stephen's  day,  the  third  Sunday  in  Advent, 
and  the  first  in  Lent.  These  were  composed 
or  adapted  in  1549  and  1661. 

III.  With  regard  to  the  sources  from 
which  we  derive  our  collects.  Dean  Comber 
says,  "  In  the  Prayer  Book  of  the  Church  of 
England  the  collects  may  be  ranked  in  three 
classes.  First,  the  ancient  primitive  collects, 
containing  nothing  but  true  doctrine,  void 
of  all  modern  coiTuptions,  and  having  a 
strain  of  the  primitive  devotion,  being 
short,  but  regular,  and  very  expressive  ;  so 
that  it  is  not  possible  to  touch  more  sense 
in  so  few  words.  That  most  are  very 
ancient,  appears  by  their  conformity  to  the 
Epistles  and  Gospels,  which  were  selected 
by  St.  Hierom,  and  put  into  the  lectionary 
ascrited  to  him.  Many  believed  he  first 
framed  them  for  the  use  of  the  Eoman 
Church,  in  the  time  of  Pope  Damasus,  a.d. 
376.  Certain  it  is  that  Gelasius,  who  was 
bishop  of  Kome  a.d.  492-6,  did.  arrange 
those  collects,  which  were  then  used,  into 
order,  and  composed  some  new  ones ;  and 
that  office  of  his  was  again  corrected  by  Pope 
Gregory  the  Great,  a.d.  600,  whose  Saora- 
mentary  contains  most  of  those  collects 
which  we  now  use,  with  some  additions 
made  to  it  by  the  abbot  Grimoaldus.  Many 
of  these  were  retained  in  their  native  purity 
in  the  Missals  of  York  and  Salisbury,  and 
the  Breviaries.  The  second  order  of  collects 
are  also  ancient  as  to  the  main ;  but  where 
there  were  any  passages  that  had  been 
corrupted,  they  were  struck  out,  and  the 
old  form  restored,  or  that  passage  rectified ; 
and  where  there  was  any  defect  it  was  sup- 
plied. The  third  order  are  such  as  had 
been  corrupted  in  the  Eoman  Missals 
and  Breviaries,  and  contained  something 
of  false  doctrine,  or  at  least  of  superstition, 
in  them ;  and  new  collects  were  made, 
instead  of  these,  at  the  Eefonnation, 
under  King  Edward  VI. ;  and  some  ■  few 
which  were  wanting  were  added,  anno 
1661." 

Entering  more  particularly  into  the  sub- 
ject, we  find  that  most  of  the  collects  are 
substantially  prior  to  the  Eefonuation,  and 
indeed  of  the  greatest  antiquity.  The  two 
prayers  recorded  in  the  Acts  of  the 
Apostles  (i.  24,  25 ;  iv.  24  seq.)  have  ai 
striking  resemblance  to  the  prayers  we  now 
know  as  collects ;  and  they  may  have  been 
patterns  for  the  forms  used  by  the  early 
Christians  But  those  which  can  be  satis- 
factorily traced  are  in  the  fragmentary 
Sacramentary,  called  the  Leonine,  after  Leo 
the  Great,  c.  a.d.  420 ;  in  the  Sacramentary  of 


COLLECTS 

Gelasius,  c.  a.d.  492 ;  and  in  that  of  Gregory- 
ISO  years  later. 

1.  Five  collects  are  "  Leonine,"  the  third 
after  Easter;  the  fifth,  ninth,  thirteenth, 
and  fourteenth  after  Trinity. 
.  2.  The  Gelasian  Sacramentary  adds  the 
second  and  part  of  the  third  morning  collect, 
the  second  and  third  evening  collects,  the 
collects  for  the  fourth  Sunday  in  Advent, 
Innocents'  day.  Palm  Sunday,  two  for  Good 
Friday,  first  half  of  that  for  Easter  Day,  for 
the  fourth  and  fifth  Sundays  after  Easter, 
and  first,  second,  sixth,  seventh,  eighth, 
eleventh,  fifteenth,  sixteenth,  eighteenth, 
nineteenth,  twentieth,  twenty-tirst  after 
Trinity,  with  portions  of  the  tenth  and 
twelfth  ;  the  collects  "Assist  us  mercifully  " 
at  the  end  of  H.  Communion,  and  "  0  Lord, 
we  beseech  Thee,"  in  the  Commination  service. 

3.  Gregory,  who  revised  and  abridged  the 
Gelasian  Sacramentary,  added  the  collects  for 
St.  Stephen's  Day;  St.; John  the  Evangelist's; 
Epiphany ;  first,  second,  third,  fourth,  fifth 
SundaysafterEpiphany:Septuagesima,Sexa- 
gesima ;  second,  third,  fourth,  fifth  Sundays 
iuLent;  one  for  Good  Friday;  the  other  partof 
the  Easter  collect ;  Ascension ;  Whitsunday; 
third,  fourth,  seventeenth,  twenty-second, 
twenty-third,  twenty-fourth,  twenty-fifth 
Sundays  after  Trinity ;  Purification  ;  Annun- 
ciation; St.  Michael;  "0  God,  whose 
nature,"  "  Prevent  us,"  with  parts  of  others. 

4.  In  1549  the  collects  for  first  and  second 
Sundays  in  Advent,  Christmas  Day,  Circum- 
cision, Quinquagesima,  Ash- Wednesday,  first 
Sunday  in  Lent,  third  for  Good  Friday,  first 
and  second  Sundays  after  Easter,  together 
with  thethird,  fifth  and  sixthat  the  end  of  the 
communion  office,  the  collect  for  commimion 
of  the  sick,  were  added.  The  collects  for 
many  of  the  Saints'  days  were  changed,  as 
they  referred  to  the  intercession  of  Saints.  In 
1552  threecoUectswere  struck  out — for  "first 
communion,"  on  Christmas-day,  for  Easter- 
day,  and  for  St.  Mary  Magdalene.  (See 
Calendar^ 

5.  In  1661  two  new  collects — third  Sun- 
day in  Advent,  and  sixth  after  Epiphany 
— were  inserted;  and  the  collect  for  St. 
Stephen's  day  considerably  altered.  The  col- 
lect for  second  Sunday  after  Epiphany,  four- 
teenth seventeenth,  twenty-tirst,  twenty- 
third  after  Trinity,  Annunciation,  and  that 
in  the  Commination,  are  literally  repro- 
duced in  English,  and  others  are  translated 
nearly  word  for  word.  But  generally  there 
are  alterations  or  amplifications,  as  indeed 
the  difference  of  idiom  between  the  Latin 
and  English  would  often  require ;  and  in 
.some  cases  a  change  was  deemed  necessary 
in  consequence  of  the  extravagance  of  super- 
stition into  which  the  Church  in  the  Middle 
Ages  had  fallen. 

it  is  not  necessary   to   quote   a    multi- 


OOLLEGE 


213 


tude  of  writers  to  show  what  has  always 
been  felt  with  regard  to  the  collects.  "  It 
is,"  says  Canon  Bright  {Ancient  Collects,  198) 
"  the  wonderful  blending  of  strength  and 
sweetness,  in  the  collects,  which  has  called 
forth  so  much  love  and  admiration,  and  has 
made  them  such  a  bond  of  union  for  pious 
minds  of  different  times  and  countries  ; " 
and  Lord  Macaulay  speaks  of  "  those 
beautiful  collects  which  have  soothed  the 
griefs  of  forty  generations  of  Christians " 
{Hist.  Ewj.  i.  160).  Among  the  advantages 
in  making  use  of  these  short  collects  are  (i.) 
the  relief  they  give  to  the  worshipper  ;  (ii.) 
the  variety  they  throw  into  the  service ; 
(iii.)  the  fixing  of  attention  by  new  impulses 
of  thought ;  (iv.)  the  solemnizing  of  the  mind 
by  frequent  invocations ;  (v.)  the  constant 
reference  of  all  our  hopes  to  the  merits  and 
mediation  of  Christ,  in  whose  name  every 
collect  is  oH'ered  ;  and  (vi.)  the  inspiring 
feeling,  that  in  them  we  are  offering  up  our 
prayers,  in  the  same  words  which  have 
been  on  the  lips  of  the  martyrs  and  saints 
of  all  ages. — Hooker,  bk.  v.  c.  33,  who 
quotes  St.  Augustine,  Ep.  130 ;  Bingham, 
xiv.  c.  i.  s.  7 ;  Canon  Bright,  Ancient 
Collects ;  On  the  Collects,  S.  P.  C.  K. 
Prayer  Book;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  iQ3.  [H.] 
COLLEGE.  A  community.  Hence  we 
speak  of  an  episcopal  college,  or  college  of 
bishops.  It  was  an  old  maxim  of  Koman 
law  that  a  college  could  not  be  formed 
of  fewer  than  three  persons.  Hence,  as  a 
bishop  is  to  be  consecrated  not  by  a  single 
bishop,  but  by  a  synod  or  college,  at  least 
three  are  required  to  be  present  at  each 
consecration.  Every  corporation,  in  the 
civil  law,  is  called  a  college,  and  so  it  has 
been  applied  in  England,  in  some  rare  in- 
stances, irrespective  of  social  combinations  : 
and  abroad  it  was  very  extensively  applied 
to  incorporated  boards.  But  in  England  it 
generally  implies  a  society  of  persons,  living 
in  a  common  habitation,  and  bound  together 
by  statutes  which  have  respect  to  their  daily 
life.  The  colleges  of  the  universities,  and 
those  of  Eton  and  Winchester,  are  specially 
so  termed :  and  some  residences  for  the 
members,  a  chapel,  hall,  and  library,  are 
considered  essential  features  of  the  college. 
Our  academical  colleges  were  all  instituted 
for  the  promotion  of  godliness,  as  well  as  of 
hiiman  knowledge,  and  as  handmaids  of  the 
Church,  and  their  recent  secularisation  was 
a  mere  act  of  violence  by  the  State.  All 
cathedral  and  collegiate  churches  are  col- 
leges ;  and  the  word  in  this  sense  compre- 
hends all  the  members  of  each  establishment, 
whether  inferior  or  superior.  The  buildings 
of  some  of  our  cathedrals  containing  the 
residence  of  the  members,  are  still  often 
popularly  called  "  the  college,"  as  at  Wor- 
cester.    The  word  is  also  applied  to  those 


214 


COLLEGIATE 


inferior  corporations  attaclied  to  the  cathe- 
drals of  old  foundation.  (See  Minor  Canons, 
and  Vicars  Choral.) 

The  colleges  of  our  universities  are  each 
independent  societies,  having  their  own 
statutes,  and  joroperty  as  strictly  their  own 
as  that  of  any  lay  proprietor.  Still  they 
are  connected  with  a  greater  corporation, 
which  is  called  the  university.  It  has  heen 
commonly  thought,  that  these  relations 
between  minor  and  major  academical  cor- 
porations is  an  anomaly  peculiar  to  England. 
The  fact  is  oth  er wise.  The  most  ancient  uni- 
versities, as  Paris,  Bologna,  and  Salamanca, 
had  each  several  colleges,  which  bore  an 
analogous  relation  to  the  university.  (See 
University.) 

COLLEGIATE  CHURCHES.  Churches 
with  a  body  of  canons  and  prebendaries, 
&c.,  and  inferior  members,  with  corporate 
privileges.  The  services  and  forms  in  these 
churches  are,  or  ought  to  be,  like  those  in 
cathedral  churches.  The  number  of  col- 
legiate churches  has  been  much  diminished 
since  the  Reformation ;  Westminster  and 
Windsor  alone  remain.  Southwell,  Wolver- 
hampton, Middleham,  and  Brecon,  were  abo- 
lished by  the  Cathedral  Reform  Act  of  1840. 
COLLYRIDIANS.  Certain  heretics,  ac- 
cording to  Bpiphanius  all  females,  who 
worshipped  the  Virgin  Mary  as  a  goddess, 
and  offered  cake  in  sacrifice  to  her.  They 
appeared  in  the  fourth  century,  about  the 
year  373,  coming  from  Thrace  and  Soythia. 
'J'heir  name  is  derived  from  KoWvpls,  a  little 
cake. — -Epiphan.  Hxres.  Ixxviii.,  ikxix. 

COLO  URS.  I.  The  use  of  different  colours 
in  the  vestments  and  ornaments  of  the 
church,  to  mark  certain  seasons,  does  not 
appear  to  have  been  adopted  in  the  very 
early  ages  of  Christianity,  but  there  were 
particular  ideas  connected  with  the  various 
colours.  White  was  the  symbol  of  purity, 
and  as  such  was  worn  by  all  ranks  of  the 
ministry:  sometimes  striped  with  purple, 
sometimes  embroidered  with  gold  (Theod. 
lib.  ii.  c.  27 ;  St.  Jerom.  lib.  i.  cont.  Pelag. ; 
Marriott's  Eist.  Christ,  xxii.).  Newly  baptized 
persons  wore  white  during  the  eight  days 
immediately  following  their  baptism  (see 
Chrisome),  (Cyril.  Catech.  Myst.  4,  n.  2; 
Socr.  lib.  V.  c.  8) ;  and  angels  and  saints  were 
depicted  as  clad  in  white  robes — for  thus 
was  symbolized  the  pure  light  of  truth. 
(Clem.  Alex.  Pmdag.  ii.  10;  Dionys.  De 
Hierarch.  Csslest.  c.  15.)  Red  would  natu- 
rally imply  fire,  and  was  connected  with 
the  idea  ot  ardent  affections  or  impulses — 
"  the  angelic  squadron  turned  fiery  red" 
(Milt.  Par.  Lost,  bk.  iv.  ad  fin.) ;  green  is  the 
colour  of  life  and  growth,  the  idea  being 
taken  from  living  vegetation  (Dionys.  De 
Hierarch.  ut  supra),  and  violet — black  and 
red  combined — symbolized  sorrow  and  love. 


COLOTJES 

Our  Lord,  as  the  loving  "Man  of  Sorrows,''  is 
depicted  in  ancient  mosaics  (as  at  Ravenna 
and  Milan)  in  a  violet  garb.  Those  virgins 
who  in  ancient  times  forsook  the  pleasures 
of  the  world  and  adopted  the  religious  life 
wore  violet  veils.  (Jerome,  Epist.  22  ad 
Eustoch.)  In  the  work  of  Innocent  III.,  de 
Sacro  Altaris  Mysterio,  the  colours  are 
sjwken  of  as  arranged  in  due  order  (Ub.  i.  c. 
65),  and  probably  they  were  used  consider- 
ably earlier  than  that  date. 

II.  With  regard  to  the  Church  of  England 
we  may  judge  as  to  the  "colours"  used, 
from  (1)  the  different  "  Uses,"  Bangor, 
Hereford,  York,  but  especially  the  Salisbury- 
"  Use,"  which  seems  to  have  been  gener- 
ally preferred  (Wilkins,  Cone.  iii.  861),. 
(2)  the  directions  in  the  Prayer  Book  of 
1549,  and  (3)  the  inventories  of  ornaments.- 
which  were  made  in  1552-3,  according  to 
instructions  to  the  commissioners  appointed 
to  survey  the  Church  goods  throughout 
the  kingdom.  Many  of  these  inventories 
are  preserved  in  the  Public  Record  Office, 
Fetter  'Lane,  London.  In  the  "  Ritual  In- 
troduction to  the  Prayer  Book"  (Blunt's 
Annot.  P.  B.,  pp.  Ixxv.  seq.)  Mr.  Perry 
gives  the  results  of  a  careful  comparison 
between  the  inventories  of  the  cathedrals 
(Holy  Trinity,  Winchester,  and  St.  Paul's), 
two  London  churches  (St.  Martin  Outwich,. 
and  St.  Nicolas,  Cole  Abbey),  and  a  country 
church  (Stanford-in-the-Vale,  Berks),  with 
the  Sarum  Missal,  and  St.  Osmund's  Register^ 
The  Ronjan  rule  is  strict,  the  Eastern 
Church  never  gave  minute  rules  as  to 
colours.  The  comparative  table  of  colours 
according  to  the  English  and  Roman  use- 
was  thus  draivn  out : — 

COMPARATIVE  TABLE  OF  COLOURS  ACCORD- 
ING TO  THE  SARUM  AND  ROMAN  USE. 


Seasons. 

Sardm. 

ROJIAK. 

Advent,  Sundays  in     .     .     . 

R. 

V. 

„        "Week  days  in     .     . 

B. 

V. 

Christmas,  Octave  of    .     .     . 

W. 

W. 

„          rest  of  ...     . 

w. 

W. 

Epiphany,  Octave  of    .     .     . 

w. 

W. 

,.          rest  of  ...     . 

Uncertain. 

G. 

Septuagesima  to  Easter  Sun- 

days      

R. 

V. 

Week  days  cFerial)     .     .     . 

E.  or 

V. 

Ash-Wednesday     .     .     .     ." 

purple. 
R. 

v 

Maundy-Thursday .... 
Good  Friday 

E. 
E. 

V. 
B 

FjisterEve 

E. 

V.  (\Vhlte 

for  Jfass.) 

AV 

Easter  throughout       ,     .     . 

W. 

Ascension,  Octave  of  .     .     . 

W. 

W. 

rest  of .     .     .     . 

Vf. 

W. 

Vigil  of  Pentecost  .... 

E.  (.') 

V.  (Ri-d 

Pentecost      

R. 

for  Mass.-) 
R 

Vigil  of  Holy  Trinity  .     .     . 

R. 

E. 

Trinity  Sunday 

E.  (?) 

W. 

Sundays  in  Trinity       .     .     . 

R 

G. 

Week  diys  (Ferial)  in  Trinity 

0. 

G. 

COMES 

COMPARATIVE  TABLE— con^mMerf. 


COMMENTARY 


215 


Fkstival",  ktc] 

Circumcision  and  Transfigu- 
ration   

Festival  of  the  Name  of  Jesus 

Festivals  of  the  Holy  Cross    . 

Festivals  of  the  B.  V.  Mary  . 

St.  Michael  and  All  AnRcls   . 

St.  John  Baptist,  Nativity  of. 
"  >t        Beheading  of 

Apostles,  out  of  Eastertide    . 

St.  John  Evangelist  in  Christ- 
mastide 

St.  John  Evangelist,  ante 
port.  Lat 

Conversion  of  St.  Paul.     .     . 

Lammas  day,  St.  Peter  ad 
Vine 

Evangelists,  out  of  Eastertide 

All  Martyrs 

„         in  Paschal  time  . 

Holy  Innocents,  if  not  Sunday 
M  „         if  Sunday     . 

Confessors 

All  Saints 

Ember  seasons 

Rogation  days 

Masses  for  the  dead     .     .     . 

OflBces  for  the  dead.     .     .     , 

Vigils 

Dedication  of  a  Church,  Octave 

of 

Processions 


SAP.U5I. 


W. 
W. 
R. 
W. 

w. 

Uncertain. 
R. 
R. 

W. 

Uncertain. 


E. 
R. 
W. 
R. 
prob.  Y 
Y. 
W. 
Uncertain. 

B. 

Blue  or 

purple. 

Uncertain. 

W. 
R. 


ROJtAN. 


w. 

W. 

E. 

W. 

W. 

R. 

E. 

E. 

W. 

E. 
W. 

W. 

R. 

E. 

W. 

V. 

E. 

W. 

W. 

V. 

V. 

B. 

B. 

V. 

W. 
V. 


[H.] 
COMES.     An  ancient  Lectionary,  or  ar- 
rangement of  epistles  and  gospels,  attributed 
to  St.  Jerome.     The  antiquity  of  this  has 
been  doubted,  and  it  is  by  some  supposed 
to  be  not  earlier  than  the  seventh  century 
(Diet.    Christ.    Ant.   ii.    962).      Bingham 
says,  referring  to  Stillinjifleet,  Orig.  Britan. 
c.  4,  p.  229,  and  Cave,  Eist.  Lit.  vol.  i.  p.  225, 
that  the  Comes  is  reckoned  "  a  counterfeit, 
and  the  work  of  a  much  later  writer,  because 
it  mentions  lessons  out  of  the  Old  Testament, 
whereas,  in  St.  Jerome's  time,  there  were  no 
lessons  read  besides  the  epistles  and  gospels 
in  the  Church  of  Rome."    It  is  interesting 
to  observe  that  in  a  foundation  deed  belong- 
ing to  a  church  in  France,  called  "  Charta 
Cornutiana,"   the   "  Comes  "  is  mentioned, 
and  this  charta  is  as  early  as  a.d.   471 
(Mabillon,  Lit.  Gall.  Pref.  vii.);  that  no 
saints  are  mentioned  in  the  Comes  of  a  later 
date  than  the  time  of  St.  Jerome;  and  the 
Epiphany  is  called  by  the  name  of  the 
Theophania,  which  was  only  used  in  the 
early  times  of  the  Western  Church.     It  is 
mentioned  by  Amalarius(iii.  40),  andMicro- 
logus  (xxv.),  who  speaks  of  it  as  "Liber 
Comitis   sive  Lectionarius,   quern   Sanctus 
Hieronymus    compaginavit."     It  is  to   be 
found  in  the  Liturgicon  Ecdesias  Latinx  of 
Pamelius  under  the  name  of  St.  Jerome,  and 
is  also  in  the  eleventh  volume  of  St.  Jerome's 
works,  p.  526. — Bingham,  bk.  xiv.  c.  iii. ; 
Maskell,   Mon.   Bit.   Eccl.   Ang.   i.  Iviii. ; 
Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  p.  70 ;  Blunt's  Diet. 
Tlceol.  p.  133.    [H.] 
COMFORTABLE  WORDS  :  texts  read 


in  the  Holy  Communion  office  immediately 
after  the  Absolution.  .This  is  peculiar  to 
the  English  Liturgy,  and  the  use  seems  to 
have  been  derived  from  the  "  Consultation  " 
of  Archbishop  Herman. 

COMMANDERIES.  New  houses  of  the 
same  kind  among  the  Knights  Hospitallers 
as  the  Preceptories  among  the  Templars. 
(See  Preceptories.) 

COMMANDMENTS,  THE  TEN.  The 
use  of  these  in  the  Communion  service  is 
peculiar  to  the  English  Church.  It  is 
probably  derived  from  the  custom  of  reciting 
and  expounding  them  at  certain  intervals, 
as  enjoined  by  ancient  synods  and  bishops. 
They  were  introduced  into  the  Communion 
ofiBce  in  1552,  before  which  time  the  collect 
for  Purity  was  followed  by  the  Introit,  which 
again  was  followed  by  the  Kyrie  Eleison 
repeated  nine  times,  as  in  the  old  service. 
(See  Eyrie.')  In  the  American  P.  B.,  and 
in  the  Scotch,  our  Lord's  summary  of  the 
law  (St.  Matt.  xxii.  37-40)  is  allowed  instead 
of  the  Decalogue.  The  translation  of  the 
commandments  in  our  Prayer  Book  is  that 
of  the  Great  Bible  of  1539-40,  not  of  the 
present  version. 

COMMEMORATIONS.  The  recital  of 
the  names  of  famous  martyrs  and  confessors, 
patriarchs,  bishops,  kings,  great  orthodox 
writers,  mtmificent  benefactois :  which  reci- 
tation was  made  at  the  altar  out  of  diptyehs 
or  folded  tables.  I'here  are  Commemoration 
days  at  Oxford  and  Cambridge,  on  which 
the  names  of  all  the  known  benefactors 
to  the  universities  are  proclaimed,  special 
psalms  and  lessons  recited,  and  special 
collects  and  versicles.  These  have  been 
coeval  with  the  Reformation,  and  sanctioned 
by  the  hi;ihest  authority.     (See  Diptyehs.) 

COMM  END  AM.  Commendam  is  a  living 
eommended  by  the  Crown  to  the  care  of  a 
clergyman  until  a  proper  pastor  is  provided 
for  it.  These  commendams  for  some  time 
have  been  seldom  if  ever  granted  to  any 
but  bishops,  who,  when  their  bishoprics  were 
of  small  value,  were,  by  special  disjiensation, 
allowed  to  hold  their  previous  benefices, 
which,  on  their  promotion,  had  devolved 
into  the  patronage  of  the  Crown.  But  by 
6  &  7  Will.  IV.  s.  18,  it  was  enacted  that 
every  commendam  thereafter  granted  shall 
be  absolutely  void. 

COMMENDATORY  LETTERS.  (See 
Literal  formats.) 

COMMENTARY.  An  exposition ;  a  book 
of  annotations  on  Holy  Scripture. 

To  give  a  complete  list  of  commentaries, 
or  a  history  of  commentators,  "would  re- 
quire a  volume  of  no  ordinary  dimensions," 
ranging  from  the  earliest  ages  of  Christianity 
to  the  present  day.  Much  interesting  in» 
formation  will  be  found  in  Rosenmiiller's 
JSistoria    Interpreiationis    Librorum    So' 


216 


COmilNATION 


crorum  in  Ecdesid  Christiana,  indc  ab 
Apostolorum  JEtate  ttsqtie  ad  Ori(/enem, 
1795-1814."  This  elaborate  work  treats 
exclusively  of  the  early  commentators. 

In  selecting  a  commentary  much  care  is 
necessary,  because  a  skilful  commentator 
Gay  "wi'est  tbe  Scriptures  so  as  to  make 
them  support  his  private  opinion.  In  the 
midst  of  a  great  many  speculative  writings 
with  regard  to  the  Bible,  there  was,  till 
lately,  a  want  of  some  free  commentarj' 
upon  the  sacred  books,  in  which  the  latest 
information  might  be  made  accessible  to 
men  of  ordinary  culture,  on  some  kind  of 
authoritative  basis.  In  1863,  the  Speaker 
of  the  House  of  Commons,  the'  Eight  Hon. 
J.  Evelyn  Denison,  consulted  some  of  the 
bishops  as  to  the  best  way  of  supplying  the 
deficiency,  and  the  result  was  the  work, 
kno^vn  by  the  name  of  the  "  Speaker's 
Commentary."  In  this  the  Authorised 
Version  from  the  edition  of  1611,  with  the 
marginal  references  and  renderings,  is  re- 
printed ;  and  comments,  chiefly  explanatory, 
but  presenting  in  a  concise  form  the  results 
of  learned  investigations,  carried  on  in  this 
and  other  countries  during  the  last  half 
century,  are  given.  The  committee  con- 
sisted of  ten  members,  the  archbishops  of 
Canterbury  and  York  heading  the  list,  and 
the  editorship  was  entrusted  to  the  Rev. 
Canon  Cook.  "  The  editor  thought  it 
desirable  to  have  a  small  committee  of 
reference,  in  cases  of  dispute,  and  the  Arch- 
bishop of  York,  with  the  Regius  Professors 
of  Divinity  of  Oxford  and  Cambridge,  agreed 
to  act  in  this  capacity."  (Preface,  Speaker's 
Commentary.')  There  were  about  forty  con- 
tributors, each  book  having  been  assigned 
to  some  writer  who  "had  paid  particular 
attention  to  the  subject  of  it." 

A  simple  and  short,  but  very  excellent 
commentary,  has  been  published  by  the 
S,  P.  C.  K.  To  this  also  there  are  many 
contributors.  Commentaries  on  portions 
of  the  Scripture  are  too  numerous  to  be 
mentioned,  but  no  list  would  be  complete 
without  the  late  Bishop  Wordsworth's  Com- 
mentary on  the  Old  and  New  Testament, 
the  late  Dean  Alford  on  the  New,  Bishops 
EUicott  and  Lightfoot  on  various  Epistles, 
and  Dr.  Pusey  on  Daniel  and  the  minor 
Prophets.    (See  Testament.)     [H.] 

COMMINA'ITON,  means  a  threat  or  de- 
nunciation of  vengeance.  I.  The  ofiBce  in 
the  Church  of  England  is  entitled  "A 
Commination,  or  denouncing  of  God's  Anger 
and  Judgment  against  Sinners,  with  certain 
Prayers,  to  be  used  on  the  first  Day  of 
Lent,  and  at  other  times,  as  the  Ordinary 
shall  appoint."  This  office,  says  Palmer 
(^Orig.  Liturg.  ii.  243),  is  one  of  the  last 
memorials  we  retain  of  that  solemn  peni- 
tence,  which    during    the    primitive  ages 


COJIMINATION 

occupied  so  conspicuous  a  place  in  the 
discipline  of  the  Christian  Church.  In  the 
earliest  ages,  those  who  were  guilty  of 
grievous  sins  were  solemnly  reduced  to  the 
order  of  penitents ;  they  came  fasting,  and 
clad  in  sackcloth  and  ashes,  on  the  occasion, 
and,  after  the  bishop  had  prayed  over  them, 
they  were  dismissed  from  the  church.  They 
then  were  admitted  gradually  to  the  classes 
of  liearers,  substrati  or  hneelers,  and  con- 
sistenteson  co-standers,  i.e.  allowed  to  join  in 
the  prayers,  but  not  to  partake  of  the 
Eucharist,  until  at  length,  after  long  trial 
and  exemplary  conduct,  they  were  again 
decreed  tvorthy  of  communion.  To  this 
discipline  St.  Basil  (a.d.  370)  refers,  and  an 
account  of  it  is  given  by  Gratian.  (Bas. 
Can.  22,  56,  seq. ;  Grat.  Diet.  50,  cap.  64.) 
But  at  length,  from  various  causes,  it  became 
extinct,  both  in  the  Eastern  and  Western 
Churches ;  and,  from  the  twelfth  or  thirteenth 
century,  the  solemn  office  of  the  first  day  of 
Lent  was  the  only  memorial  of  this  ancient 
discipline  in  the  West.  The  Church  of 
England  has  long  used  this  office  nearly  as 
we  do  at  present,  as  we  find  almost  exactly 
the  same  appointed  in  the  MS.  Sacramentary 
of  Leofric,  which  was  written  for  our  Church 
about  the  ninth  or  tenth  century ;  and 
year  by  year  she  directs  her  ministers  to 
lament  the  defection  of  the  godly  discipline 
we  have  been  describing.  The  title  in  1549 
was  merely  "  the  First  Day  of  Lent,  com- 
monly called  Ash- Wednesday."  It  was 
altered  in  1552  at  the  suggestion  of  Bucer, 
who  wished  for  the  frequent  use  of  the 
service,  and  for  a  revival  of  open  penance, 
to  "A  commination  against  sinners,  with 
certain  prayers  to  be  used  divers  times  in 
the  year."  It  was  changed  to  its  present 
form  in  1661. 

II.  With  regard  to  the  "  other  times,  as 
the  ordinary  shall  appoint,"  it  appears  from 
the  Visitation  Articles  of  Archbishop  Grindal 
for  the  province  of  Canterbury,  in  the  year 
1576,  that  it  was  appointed  four  times  a  year ; 
namely,  on  one  of  the  three  Sundays  next 
before  Easter,  on  one  of  the  two  Sundays 
next  before  Pentecost,  and  on  one  of  the  two 
Sundays  next  before  Christmas,  as  well  as 
on  Ash- Wednesday.  Ash- Wednesday  was 
indeed  the  solemn  day  of  all,  on  which  this 
office  was  never  to  be  omitted ;  as  may  be 
gathered  from  the  preface,  which  is  drawn 
up  for  the  peculiar  use  of  that  day.  (Card- 
well's  Docum.  Annals,  i.  398.)  In  the  Scotch 
Common  Prayer,  a  clause  was  added,  that  it 
was  to  be  used  "  especially  on  the  first  day 
of  Lent,  commonly  called  Ash- Wednesday." 

But  the  service  is  now  never  made  use  of 
at  other  times  than  Ash- Wednesday,  except 
that  sometimes  the  latter  part,  from  the  51st 
Psalm  to  the  end,  has  been  said  on  solemn 
days  of  fasting  and  humiliation.    This  would 


COMMISSAEY 

he  the  "  certaiu  prayers,"  for  the  Gummina- 
tion  properly  means  that  part  of  the  special 
service  which  precedes  the  Psalm.     [H.] 

COMMISSARY,  is  a  title  of  jurisdiction, 
appertainina;  to  him  that  exercises  ecclesias- 
tical jurisdiction,  in  places  so  far  distant 
fi-om.  the  chief  city,  that  the  chancellor 
cannot  call  the  people  to  the  bishop's  prin- 
cipal consistory  court  without  great  trouble 
to  them. 

Chancellors,  or  bishops'  lawyers,  were 
first  introduced  into  the  Church  by  the  2nd 
canon  of  the  Council  of  Chalcedon,  and 
were  men  trained  up  in  the  civil  and  canon 
law,  to  direct  bishops  in  matters  of  judg- 
ment relating  to  ecclesiastical  affairs. 

Whatever  the  extent  of  the  chancellor's 
authority  as  a  judge  may  be,  throughout 
the  diocese,  with  relation  to  the  bishop's, 
it  is  quite  clear  that  the  commissary's  autho- 
rity extends  only  to  such  particular  causes, 
in  suchiparts  of  the  diocese,  for  which  he 
holds  the  bishop's  commission  to  act. 

In  the  Clementine  constitutions  this 
officer  is  termed  officialis  foraneus.  By 
21  Henry  "VIII.  cap.  13,  he  shall  not  he 
within  the  statute  of  non-residence ;  he  may 
grant  licences ;  he  may  excommunicate, 
find  prove  a  last  will  and  testament;  but 
that  shall  be  in  the  name  of  the  ordinary  ; 
and  a  grant  of  such  power  does  not  hold 
f!Ood  beyond  the  life  of  the  ordinary,  and 
does  not  bind  his  successor :  where,  by  pre- 
scription or  by  composition,  there  are  arch- 
deacons, who  have  jurisdiction  in  their 
archdeaconries,  as  in  most  places  they  have, 
there  the  oi£ce  of  commissary  is  superfluous. 
■ — See  Gibson's  Codex,  vol.  i.  Introductory 

COMMON  PRAIEB.  (See  Liturgy, 
Prayer  Book.')  By  Common  Prayer  we  are 
to  understand  a  form  of  prayer  adapted  and 
•enjoined  for  common  or  universal  use ;  in 
the  vernacular  language,  such  as  may  be 
understood  of  people,  and  in  which  they  are 
required  to  join  with  one  heart  and  voice. 
The  term  is  very  ancient,  being  found  in 
use  as  far  back  as  St.  Cyprian's  time  (a.d. 
252),  who  speaks  of  the  Lord's  Prayer  as 
■"  Publica  nobis,  et  communis  oratio."  This 
refers  to  our  blessed  Lord's  own  words, 
"  When  two  or  three  are  gathered  together 
in  My  Name,  there  am  I  in  the  midst  of 
them  "  (St.  Matt,  xviii.  20).  The  joining 
thus  together  in  prayer,  is  a  holy  duty,  and 
lias  been  observed  in  all  ages  ;  the  ordained 
minister  leading  the  prayers,  and  the  con- 
gregation joining  with  him.  This  was  incul- 
cated by  many  canons,  as  for  instance  the  so- 
called  Apostolic  Canon  (7),  which  suspended 
those  who  did  not  join  in  prayers.  (See  also 
Cone.  Antioch.  can.  2  ;  Cone.  Eliher.  cau.  621, 
■&c.)  In  the  Church  of  England  the  term 
^eems  first  to  have  been  used  authoritatively 


COMMUNION 


217 


in  a  rubric  to  the  English  Litany  of  1544, 
which  runs,  "It  is  thought  convenient  in 
this  common  prayer  of  Procession,  to  have 
it  set  forth,  and  used  in  the  vulgar  tongue, 
for  stirring  the  people  to  more  devotioa ; " 
and  it  occurs  again  in  the  Injunctions  of 
Edward  VI.,  issued  in  1546-7. 

Bishop  Sparrow  observes,  that  the  Common 
Prayer  contains  in  it  many  holy  offices  of 
the  Church ;  as  prayers,  confessions  of  faith, 
holy  hymns,  divine  lessons,  priestly  ab- 
solutions, and  benedictions ;  all  which  are 
set  and  prescribed,  not  left  to  private  men's 
fancies  to  make  or  alter.  So  it  was  of  old 
oi-dained  {Cone.  Carthag.  can.  106,  and  in 
many  others).  "  It  is  ordained,  that  the 
prayers,  prefaces,  and  impositions  of  hands, 
which  are  confirmed  by  the  synod,  be  ob- 
served and  used  by  all  men  :  these,  and  no 
other."  So  is  our  14th  English  canon.  .  .  . 
"  And  as  these  offices  are  set  and  prescribed, 
so  are  they  moreover  appointed  to  be  one 
and  the  same  throughout  the  whole  national 
Church."  Canons  4,  38,  98,  deal  with  those 
who  would  reject,  or  fail  to  use  the  order  of 
Common  Praj'cr. 

COMMUiSION.    (See  Holy  Communion, 

JLUcJui7"hSii   I 

COMMUNION  OF  THE  SICK.  I.  Al- 
though the  Church  maintains  that  the 
Eucharist,  as  a  general  rule,  is  to  be  publicly 
administered  in  the  consecrated  house  of 
God,  and  has  siguiBed  her  disapproval  of 
solitary  communion  in  all  cases ;  yet,  when 
by  sickness  her  members  are  incapable  of 
presenting  themselves  at  the  altar,  there  is 
a  wise  and  tender  relaxation  of  her  usages, 
corresponding  with  the  peculiar  necessity  of 
the  case.  This  is  in  accordance  with  the 
earliest  practice  of  thej primitive  Church; 
as  is  plainly  shown  in  the  writings  of  the 
Fathers,  in  canons  and  other  ancient  docu- 
ments. In  the  Western  Church  the  Eucharist 
administered  to  a  sick  person  was  called 
viaticum,  in  the  Eastern  e<p6Si.ov,  both 
words  denoting  provision  for  a  journey — 
the  journey  to  the  other  world.  When  St. 
Clement  of  Eome  uses  the  term  to  i(f)6di.a 
Tov  0(ov,  he  does  not  necessarily  imply 
the  Eucharist ;  but  his  namesake  ^of  Alex- 
andria joined  to  it  the  words  fcoTjs-  alSiov, 
which  resemble  the  words  in  the  liturgies 
of  St.  James,  St.  Basil,  and  St.  Mark,  C^ijs 
alaviov,  which  are  used  in  a  manner 
clearly  denoting  the  Eucharist.  (Clem.  Alex. 
Strom. vL  33;  Hammond,  Liturgies,^.  191.) 
The  Council  of  Nice  (can.  xiii.)  forbad  that 
any,  even  the  lapsed,  should  be  deprived  of 
the  very  last  and  most  necessary  €(p68cov, 
and  this  was  repeated  by  other  councils,  as 
the  4th  of  Carthage,  a.d.  398  (can.  Ixxvii.), 
"  Qui  in  infirmitate  sunt  viaticum  acoipiant," 
of  Epaon,  a.d.  517  (can.  xxxvi.),  and  many 
others. 


218 


COMMUNION 


"  There  are  mauy  instances,''  saj'S  Palmer 
{Orig.  Liturgy,  ii.  232),  "in  antiquity,  of 
the  celebration  of  the  Eucharist  in  private 
for  the   sick.     Thus    Paulinus,  bishop    of 
Nola,  caused  the  Eucharist  to  be  celebrated 
in  his  own  chamber,  not  many  hours  before 
his  death.     Gregory  Nazianzen  informs  us, 
that  his  father  communicated  in  his  own 
chamber,  and  that  his  sister  had  an  altar 
at  home  (  Oral.  19,  de  Laude  Patris.  Oral.  1 1) ; 
and  Ambrose  is  said  to  have  administered 
the  sacrament  in  a  private  house  at  Rome 
(Vita   A.  a    Paidino,    can.    xlvii.).     The 
Church  is  therefore  justified  in  directing 
the  Eucharist  to  be  consecrated  in  private 
houses,  for  the  benefit  of  the  sick ;  and  she 
has  taken  care,  in  the  rubric  immediately 
preceding  the  office,  that  the  sacrament  shall 
be  decorously  and  reverently  administered." 
In  the  English  Church  great  stress  has 
always  been  laid  upon  the  reception  of  the 
Eucharist  by  the  sick.   Archbishop  Theodore 
(a.d.   671)  dwells    on  the  matter  in  his 
Penitential  (cap.  41),  which  was  the  first 
■work  published  by  authority  in  the  Western 
Church,  and  was  the  foundation  on  which 
all  the  other  "libelli  pa^nitentiales"  rested, 
such  as  those  published  by  Bede  and  Eg- 
bert (Hook's  Arclihishops,  i.  168).  The  canon 
No.  65   of  King  Edgar  (a.d.  960)  orders 
every  priest  to  give  "  housel "  to  the  sick 
when  they  need  it ;  and  a  canon  of  the 
Synod  of  Westminster  (1138)  confirms  this. 
In  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549  there  is  a  long 
rubric    with    regard     to    the    manner    of 
administering  the  Eucharist  to  sick  persons ; 
but  this  was  set  aside  in  1552  because  it 
implied  reservation  of  the  Holy  Sacrament. 
II.  By  the  present  rubric,  before  the  ofBce 
for  the  Communion  of  the  Sick,  it  is  ordered 
as  follows :  "  Forasmuch  as  all  mortal  men 
be  subject  to  many  sudden  perils,  diseases, 
and  sicknesses,  and  ever  uncertain  what 
time   they  shall  depart  out  of  this  life ; 
therefore,  to  the  intent  they  may  be  always 
in  a  readiness  to  die  whensoever  it  shall 
please  Almighty  God  to  call  them,  curates 
shall    diligently  from   time  to  time  (but 
especially  in  the  time  of  pestilence  or  other 
infectious  sickness)  exhort  their  parishioners 
to  the  often  receiving  of  the  holy  communion 
of  the  body  and  blood  of  our  Saviour  Christ, 
when  it  shall  be  publicly  administered  in 
the  church ;  that,  so  doing,  they  may,  in 
case  of   sudden  visitation,  have  the   less 
cause  to  be  disquieted  for  lack  of  the  same. 
But  if  the  sick  person  be  not  able  to  come 
to  the  church,  and  yet  is  desirous  to  receive 
the  communion  in  his  house,  then  he  must 
give  timely  notice  to  the  curate,  signifying 
also  how  many  there  are  to  communicate 
with  him,  (which  shall  he  three,  or  two  at 
the  least,)  and  having  a  convenient  place 
in  the  sick  man's   house,  with  all  things 


COMMUNION 

necessary  so  prepared,  that  the  curate  may 
reverently  minister,  he  shall  there  celebrate 
the  holy  communion." 

III.  The  reservation  of  a  portion  of  the 
elements  consecrated  in  the  church,  for  the 
use  of  the  sick,  is  probably  of  primitive 
origin.  Justin  Martyr  refers  to  this  in  his. 
Apology  (i.  65),  though  his  words  may 
include  more  than  the  sick,  as  he  says, 
**  KOL  Tols  ov  Trapovu-i  (dtaKovoi)  dirofp^povtru 
Eusebius  speaks  (quoting  from  Dionysius)  of 
a  priest,  who  being  sick,  sent  by  a  messenger 
to  a  dying  person  a  "  morsel  of  the  eucha- 
rist "  "(Euseb.  Bist.  Eccl.  vi.  44),  and  the 
canons  of  the  early  coimcils  imply  the  con- 
veying of  the  viaticum.  But  it  was  not 
allowed  to  be  conveyed  by  any  but  an 
ordained  minister,  except  under  very  par- 
ticular circumstances.  Bona  states  that 
reservation  in  the  Church  was  designed  for 
the  sick  only  (Serum  Liturg.  ii.  17),  and 
that  this  was  the  idea  in  the  English 
Church  in  early  times  is  evident  from  the 
excerpt  of  Archbishop  Egbert,  "Ut  pres- 
byter eucharistiam  habeat  semper  paratam, 
ad  infirmos,ne  sine  communione  moriantur." 
By  the  Synod  of  Westminster  above  referred 
to,  it  was  ordered  that  "  Ultra  octo  dies 
Corpus  Christi  non  reservetur  ;  "  nor  should 
it  be  conveyed  "  nisi  per  sacerdotem,  aut 
per  dlaconum,  aut  necessitate  instante, 
per  quemlibet  cum  summa  reverentia" 
(Maskell,  Man.  Hit.  i.  ccxxiii). 

By  a  constitution  of  Archbishop  Peclcham 
(a.d.  12V  9),  the  sacrament  of  the  Eucharist 
"  shall  be  carried  with  due  reverence  to  the 
sick,  the  priest  having  on  at  least  a  surplice 
or  stole,  with  a  light  carried  before  him  in  a 
lantern,  with  a  bell,  that  the  people  may  be 
excited  to  due  reverence;  who  by  the 
minister's  direction  shall  be  taught  to 
prostrate  themselves,  or  at  least  to  make 
humble  adoration,  wheresoever  the  King  of 
Glory  shall  happen  to  be  carried  under  the 
cover  of  bread." 

But  by  the  rubric  of  the  2  Edward  VI. 
it  was  ordered,  that  there  shall  be  no  eleva- 
tion of  the  host,  or  showing  the  sacrament 
to  the  people.  The  rubric  of  1549  ordered 
that,  in  the  case  of  a  sick  person,  the  priest 
shall  "  reserve  (at  the  open  communion  iia 
the  church)  so  much  of  the  sacrament  of 
the  body  and  blood  as  shall  serve  the  sick 
person,  and  so  many  as  shall  communicate 
with  him  (if  there  be  any),  and  as  soon  as 
he  conveniently  may,  after  the  open  com- 
munion ended  in  the  church,  shall  go  and 
minister  the  same,  first  to  those  that  are 
appointed  to  communicate  with  the  sick  (if 
there  be  any),  and  last  to  the  sick  person 
himself."  The  curate  was  charged  to  use 
the  general  confession,  the  absolution,  the 
comfortable  words,  and  the  collect  after  com- 
munion.    If  there  was  not  open  communion 


COMMUNION 

in  the  cliurcb,  the  curate  was  to  visit  the  sick 
person  afore  noon,  and  "  having  a  convenient 
place,"  celebrate  the  holy  communion.  A 
second  rubric  at  the  end  of  the  office  orders 
that  if  the  curate  has  to  celebrate  in  any 
sick  man's  house,  and  there  be  more  sick 
persons  to  be  visited  the  same  day,  he  shall 
reserve  so  much  as  shall  serve  the  other 
sick  persons,  and  shall  immediately  carry  it 
and  minister  it  to  them.  This  was  altered 
in  1552,  and  private  celebrations  were  alone 
provided  for,  the  present  collect,  epistle  and 
gospel  in  the  office  for  the  communion  of 
the  sick  being  then  appointed.  In  the 
Latin  Prayer  Book  of  Queen  Elizabeth's 
reign,  in  the  Scottish  Church,  and  by  the 
non-jurors,  the  practice  of  reservation  was 
upheld.  In  cases  of  great  epidemics,  it 
would  seem  to  be  in  accordance  with  a 
primitive  practice,  and  the  canons  of  ancien  t 
councils,  that  it  should  be  retained  ;  and 
when  in  the  great  outbreak  of  cholera  at 
Leeds,  Bishop  Longley,  aftenvards  arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  was  appealed  to  on 
this  subject,  he  said,  that  "while  he  could  not 
authorize  reservation,  he  did  not  feel  himself 
justified  vaforhidding  it  in  that  emergency." 
\nist.  Considerations,  &c.,  by  Ilev.  T.  W. 
Perry  ;  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  p.  290.)  The 
late  primate  (Dr.  Tait)  and  the  bishop  of 
London  (Dr.  Jackson)  are  both  said  to  have 
allowed  the  sacrament  to  be  reserved,  when 
sickness  was  prevalent  in  a  populous  London 
parish  (iii.  Churchman,  Feb.  7, 1885)  ;  but 
at  the  first  meeting  of  the  Uj^per  House  of 
Convocation  in  1885  the  question  was  dis- 
cussed, and  the  opinion  of  their  Lordships  was 
unfavourable  to  such  a  practice  {Ibid.  p.  87). 

In  view  of  an  epidemic,  one  rubric  orders 
that  "  In  the  time  of  plague,  sweat,  or  other 
such  like  contagious  times  of  sickness  or 
diseases,  when  none  of  the  parish  can  be 
gotten  to  communicate  with  the  sick  in 
their  houses,  for  fear  of  infection,  upon 
special  request  of  the  diseased,  the  minister 
may  only  communicate  with  him."  And 
another,  that  in  the  distribution  of  the 
elements  "the  sick  person  shall  receive  last." 
This  is  done,  "because  those  who  com- 
municate with  him,  through  fear  of  some 
contagion,  or  the  noisomeness  of  his  disease, 
may  be  afjaid  to  drink  out  of  the  same  cup 
after  him."     [H.] 

In  the  Sarum  Manual  provision  is  made 
for  spiritual  communion  in  cases  where 
actual  reception  of  the  elements  is  impossible ; 
and  in  the  same  way  our  rabric  directs  that 
"  if  a  man,  either  by  reason  of  extremity  of 
sickness,  or  for  want  of  warning  in  due 
time  to  the  curate,  or  for  lack  of  company 
to  receive  ivith  him,  or  by  any  other  just 
impediment,  do  not  receive  the  sacrament 
of  Christ's  body  and  blood,  the  curate  shall 
instruct  him,  that  if  he  do  truly  repent  him 


COMMUNION 


2ll> 


of  his  sins,  and  stedfastly  believe  that  Jesu^ 
Christ  hath  suffered  death  upon  the  cros^ 
for  him,  and  shed  his  blood  for  his  redemp" 
tion;  earnestly  remembering  the  benefits 
he  hath  thereby,  and  giving  him  hearty 
thanks  therefor;  he  doth  eat  and  drink 
the  body  and  blood  of  our  Saviour  Christ 
profitably  to  his  soul's  health,  although  he  do 
not  receive  the  sacrament  with  his  mouth." 
COMMUNION  OF  SAINTS.  (See 
Saints.')  This  is  an  article  of  the  Creed  in 
which  we  profess  to  believe,  as  a  necessary 
and  infallible  truth,  that  such  persons  as 
are  truly  sanctified  in  the  Church  of  Christ, 
while  they  live  among  the  crooked  genera- 
tions of  men,  and  struggle  with  the  miseries 
of  this  world,  have  fellowship  with  God  the 
Father  (1  St.  John  i.  3 ;  2  St.  Peter  i.  4),  with 
God  the  Son  (1  St.  John  i.  3 ;  2  St.  John  9  ; 
St.  Johnxvii.  20,  21,'23),  with  God  the  Holy 
Ghost  (Phil.  ii.  I  ;*  2  Cor.  xiii.  14),  as 
dwelling  with  them,  and  taking  up  their 
habitations  in  them ;  that  they  partake  of 
the  care  and  kindness  of  the  blessed  angels, 
who  take  delight  in  the  ministration  for 
their  benefit,  being  "ministering  spiiits 
sent  forth  to  minister  for  them  who  shall  be 
heirs  of  salvation  "  (Heb.  i.  14 ;  St.  Luke  xv. 
10;  St.  Matt,  xviii.  10);  that  besides  the 
external  fellowship  which  they  have  in  the 
word  and  sacraments,  with  all  the  members 
of  the  Church,  they  have  an  intimate  union 
and  conjunction  with  all  the  saints  on  eai-th,. 
as  the  living  members  of  Christ.  (1  St.  John 
i.  7  ;  Col.  ii.  19.)  Nor  is  this  union  sepa- 
rated by  the  death  of  any ;  but  as  Christ, 
in  whom  they  live,  is  the  Lamb  slain  from 
the  foundation  of  the  world,  so  have  they 
fellowship  with  all  the  saints,  who,  from 
the  death  of  Abel,  have  departed  in  the 
true  faith  and  fear  of  God,  and  now  enjoy 
the  presence  of  the  Father,  and  follow  the 
Lamb  whithersoever  he  goeth.  (Heb.  xii. 
22,  23.)  "  Indeed,"  says  Bishop  Peareon,. 
from  whom  this  article  is  taken,  "  the  com- 
munion of  saints  in  the  Church  of  Christ 
with  those  who  are  departed  is  demonstrated 
by  their  communion  with  the  saints  alive. 
For  if  I  have  communion  with  a  saint  of 
God  as  such,  while  he  liveth  here,  I  must 
still  have  communion  with  him  when  he  is 
departed  hence ;  because  the  foundation  or 
that  communion  cannot  be  removed  by 
death.  The  mystical  union  between  Christ; 
and  his  Church,  the  spiritual  conjunction 
of  the  members  with  the  head,  is  the  true 
foundation  of  that  communion  which  one 
member  hath  with  another,  all  the  members 
living  and  increasing  by  the  same  influence 
which  they  receive  from  him.  But  death, 
which  is  nothing  else  but  the  separation 
of  the  soul  from  the  body,  maketht 
no  separation  in  the  mystical  union,  no 
breach  of  the  spiritual  conjunction;   and. 


220 


COMMUNION 


consequently,  there  must  continue  the  same 
communion,   because  there  remaineth  the 
same  foundation.     Indeed,  the  saint  before 
his  death  had  some  communion  with  tlie 
hypocrite,  as  hearing  the  word,  professing 
the  faith,  receiving  the  sacraments  together ; 
which  being  in  things  only  external,  as  they 
were  common  to  them  both,  and  all  such 
external  actions  ceasing  in  the  person  dead, 
the  hjpocrite    remaining   loseth  all  com- 
munion with  the  saint  departing,  and  the 
saints  surviving  cease  to  have  farther  fellow- 
ship with  the  hypocrite  dying.     But  seeing 
that  the  true  and    unfeigned  hohness  oF 
man,  wrought  by  the  powerful  influence  of 
the  Spirit  of  God,  not  only  remaineth,  but 
also  is  improved  after  death;    seeing  that 
the  correspondence  of  the  internal  holiness 
was  the  true  communion  with  other  persons 
during    life,   they  cannot    be    said    to  be 
divided  by  dealh,   which    hath  no  power 
over  that  sanctity  by  which  they  were  first 
conjoined.     But  although  this  communion 
of  the  saints  in  paradise  and  on  earth,  upon 
the  mystical  union  of  Christ  their  head,  be 
fundamental  and  internal,  yet  what  acts  or 
external  operations  it  produces  is  not  so 
certain.     That  we  communicate  with  them 
in    hope    of   that    happiness  which    they 
actually  enjoy  is  evident ;  that  we  have  the 
Spirit  of  God  given  us  as  an  earnest,  and  so 
a  part  of  their  felicity,  is  certain.    But  what 
they  do  in  heaven  in  relation  to  us  on  earth 
particularly  considered,  or  what  we  ought 
to  perform  in  reference  to  them  in  heaven, 
besides  a  reverential  respect  and  study  of 
imitation,  is  not  revealed   unto  us  in  the 
Scriptures,  nor  can  be  concluded  by  ne- 
cessary deduction  from  any  principles  of 
Christianity.     They  who  first  found  this 
part  of  the  article  in  the  Creed,  and  delivered 
their  exposition  to  us,  have  made  no  greater 
enlargement  of  this  communion,  as  to  the 
saints  of  heaven,  than  the  society  of  hope, 
esteem,  and  imitation  on  ouv  side,  of  desires 
and  supplications  on  their  side ;  and  what  is 
now  taught  by  the  Church  of  Rome  is  as  an 
imwarrantable,  soanovitious,  interpretation." 
COMMUNION  IN  ONE  KIND.     "  The 
principal  advocates  of  Popery  at  the  begin- 
ning of  the  Reformation  were  not  willing 
to  own,  that  the  universal  practice  of  the 
primitive  Church  was  against  the  modem 
sacrilege  of  denying  the  cup  to  the  people ; 
and,  therefore,  though  they  confessed  there 
were  some  instances  in  antiquity,  of  com- 
munion under  both  kinds,  yet  they  main- 
tained the  custom  was  not  universal.     So 
Eckius    and    Harding,   and    many  others. 
But  they  who  have  since   considered  the 
practice    of    the     ancient    Church    more 
narrowly,  are  ashamed  of  this  pretence,  and 
freely  confess,   that   for    twelve    centuries 
there  is  no  instance  of  the  people's  being 


COMMUNION 

obliged  to  communicate  only  in  one  kind, 
in  the  public  administration  of  the  sacra- 
ment ;  but  in  private  they  think  some  few 
instances  may  be  given." 

This  is  shown  by  Leo  AUatius  (de  Missa 
Priesanct.  p.  1559),  and  not  denied  by 
Cardinal  Bona,  who  says  {Ber.  Liturg.  lib.  ii. 
c.  18),  "it  is  very  certain  that  anciently 
all  in  general,  both  clergy  and  laity,  men 
and  women,  received  the  holy  mysteries  in 
both  kinds,  when  they  were  present  at  the 
solemn  celebration  of  them,  and  they  both 
offered  and  were  partakers.  But  out  of  the 
time  of  sacrifice,  and  act  of  the  Church,  it 
was  customary  always  and  in  all  places  to 
communicate  only  in  one  kind.  In  the  first 
part  of  the  assertion  all  agree,  as  well 
Catholics  as  sectaries ;  nor  can  any  one 
deny  it,  that  has  the  least  knowledge  ot 
ecclesiastical  affairs.  For  the  faithful  always 
and  in  all  places,  from  the  very  first  found- 
ation of  the  Church  to  the  twelfth  century, 
were  used  to  commmiicate  under  the  species 
of  bread  and  wine ;  and  in  the  begiiming  of 
that  age  the  use  of  the  cup  began  by  little 
and  little  to  be  laid  aside,  whilst  many 
bishops  interdicted  the  people  the  use 
of  the  cup,  for  iear  of  irreverence  and 
effusion."  Before  this,  with  the  same  object 
of  reverence,  the  wine  was  in  some  places 
administered  by  the  bread  being  dipped 
into  it,  of  which  custom  mention  is  made 
in  the  third  Council  of  Braga,  held  a.d. 
675.  (See  Intinction.)  This  was  sometimes 
condemned  in  the  West,  sometimes  allowed. 
Emulf,  for  instance,  bishop  of  Rochester, 
wrote  in  favour  of  it  in  1120,  the  Synod  of 
Westminster  prohibited  it  in  1175.  In 
consequence  of  which  disputes,  according  to 
Bona,  the  Council  of  Constance,  to  settle 
the  matter,  withdrew  the  cup  altogether 
from  the  laity.  {Rer.  Liturg.  lib.  ii.  19, 
quoted  by  Bingham,  bk.  xv.  c.  5.)  The 
order  runs  that,  "  although  in  the  primitive 
Church  this  sacrament  was  received  of  the 
faithful  under  both  kinds,  yet  for  the 
avoiding  any  dangers  and  scandals,  the 
custom  has  reasonably  been  introduced, 
that  it  be  received  by  the  officiating  persons 
under  both  kinds,  but  by  the  laity  only 
imder  the  kind  of  bread ;  since  it  is  to  be 
believed  most  firmly,  and  in  nowise  to  be 
doubted,  that  the  whole  body  and  blood  of 
Christ  is  truly  contained  as  well  under  the 
species  of  bread  as  mider  that  of  wine." 

"  On  which  we  may  fairly  remark,  '  full 
well  ye  reject  the  commandment  of  God, 
that  ye  m.ay  keep  your  ovm  tradition.'  For 
Christ,  when  he  celebrated  the  Eucharist, 
gave  the  cup  to  all  who  were  present :  and 
when  He  appointed  His  Apostles  His 
ministers  to  celebrate  it,  He  bade  them  do 
the  same,  '  Do  this  in  remembrance  of  Me.* 
But  ye  s.ay,  whosoever  shall  dare  to  do  as 


COMMUNION 

Christ  has  bidden  him,  shall  be  effectually 
punished."  (Perceval  on  the  lloman  Schism.) 
At  this  day  the  Greeks,  and  Maronites,  and 
Abyssinians,  and  all  the  Orientals,  never 
communicate  but  in  both  kinds. 

COMMUNION  TABLE.  A  name  for 
the  altar  in  the  Christian  Church.  It  is 
both  altar  and  table.  An  altar  with  respect 
to  the  oblation ;  a  table  with  respect  to  the 
feast.     (See  Aliar.) 

COMMUTATION  OF  PENANCE. 
Penance  is  an  ecclesiastical  punishment, 
used  in  the  disciphne  of  the  Church,  which 
affects  the  body  of  the  penitent ;  by  which 
he  is  obUged  to  give  public  satisfaction  to  the 
Church  for  the  scandal  he  has  occasioned  by 
his  evil  example.  Commutation  of  Penance 
is  the  permission  granted  by  the  ecclesiastical 
judge  to  pay  a  certain  sum  of  money  for 
pious  uses,  in  lieu  of  public  penance.  But 
it  does  not  now  really  exist.   (See  Penitents.) 

COMPETENTES.  Catechumens  in  the 
primitive  Church,  being  the  immediate 
candidates  for  baptism.  They  had  pre- 
viously to  undergo  a  long  preparation,  being 
(1)  merely  catechumens ;  (2)  audientes,  or 
hearers  of  the  word  in  church ;  (3)  genu- 
flectentes,  allowed  to  kneel  with  the  other 
worshi[)pers ;  (4)  competentes.  St.  Cyril 
calls  them  <j)a>Ti^6fj.evoi,  the  apostolic  con- 
stitutions ^aTTT-ifd/iei/ot ;  not  as  having 
received  the  light,  or  having  been  baptized, 
but  being  in  readiness  for  baptism.  (St. 
Cyr.  Catech.  i.  2 ;  Apost.  Constit.  viii.  8.) 
The  names  of  the  candidates  were  registered 
in  the  dlTrrv^a  fmircaj/ — so  called  to  dis- 
tinguish them  from  the  other  diptychs — and 
read  out  to  the  congregation.  (See  Diptychs, 
Catechumens.) 

COMPLINE,  or  COMPLETOEIUM,  was, 
before  the  Reformation,  the  last  service  of 
the  day.  This  hour  of  prayer  was  first 
appointed  by  the  celebrated  abbot  Benedict, 
in  the  sixth  century.  "Complyn  ys  the 
seuenthe  and  the  last  howre  of  dyuyne 
seruyce,  and  yt  ys  as  moche  to  say  as  a 
fulfyllynge.  And  therwyth  also  is  ended, 
and  fuffylled  spekynge,  etynge,  and 
drynkynge,  and  laborynge,  and  all  bodyly 
besynesses.  So  that  after  that  tyme  oughte 
to  be  kepte  stylnes,  and  scylence  not  only 
from  wordes,  but  also  from  all  dedes  saue 
only  softs  prayer  and  holy  thynkeynge,  and 
bodely  sleape.  For  complyn  betokeneth  the 
ende  of  mannes  lyfe.  And  therefore  eche 
persone  oughte  to  dyspose  him  to  bedde 
warde,  as  yf  hys  bedde  were  hys  grave." — 
Tlie  Mirrour,  fol.  Ixxxix;  Maskell,  Mon. 
Hit.  iii.  67.     [H.] 

CONCEPTION  (IMMACULATE)  OF 
THE  HOLY  VIRGIN.  The  immaculate 
conception  is  a  festival  of  the  Roman 
Church,  observed  on  December  8,  in  honour 
of  the   alleged   conception  of   the   Virgin 


CONOEPTIOM 


221 


Mary  without  sin.  The  doctrine  itself  was 
invented  about  the  middle  of  the  twelfth 
century.  The  devotion  offered  to  the 
Blessed  Virgin  having  grown  to  an  extrava- 
gant height,  it  was  asserted  by  some  theo- 
logians, not  only  that  she  was  sanctified 
from  her  birth,  but  also  that  she  was  con- 
ceived without  sin.  1  he  opinion  was  at  fir^t 
generally  condemned,  and  it  would  have  had 
its  place  among  other  forgotten  heresies,  if 
Duns  Scotus,  the  great  opponent  of  the  Do- 
minicans, had  not  undertaken  its  defence. 
The  festival  was  included  in  the  English 
Calendar  for  the  first  time,  by  Archbishop 
Islip's  Constitutions,  A.D.  1362,  though  it 
has  been  said  that  it  was  included  at  Arcli- 
bishop  Langton's  Council  at  Oxford  (a.d. 
1222),  not  as  a  day  of  obligation,  but 
optional.  This  rests,  however,  only  on  one 
Belgian  MS.  (Dr.  Pusey's  Eirenicon,  ii.  365.) 

It  has  now  been  dogmatically  asserted  in 
the  Bull,  "  Ineflfabilis  Dens,"  which  was 
promulgated  on  Dec.  8,  1854,  by  the  late 
Pope  Pius  IX.,  the  substantial  point  of 
which  is  that  the  Blessed  Virgin  Mary  was, 
by  the  grace  and  favour  of  Almighty  God, 
preserved  perfectly  free  from  all  taint  of 
original  sin,  "  ex  prima  instanti  suas  con- 
ceptionis."  In  this  no  one  can  deny  that  an 
addition  has  been  made  to  the  ancient  creeds, 
and  in  a  case  to  which  even  the  loose  prin- 
ciple of  development  could  hardly  be  made 
applicable  ;  while  at  the  same  time  there  is 
animplied  condemnation  not  only  of  theprim- 
itive  fathers,  but  of  the  greatest  theologians 
whom  the  Church  has  ever  produced.    [H.] 

CONCEPTION  OP  OUB  LADY.  A 
religions  order  in  the  Romish  Church, 
founded  by  Beatrix  de  Sylva,  sister  of 
James,  first  count  of  Portolegro,  in  the  king- 
dom of  Portugal.  The  king  of  Castile 
falling  in  love  with  her,  she  fled  to  Toledo, 
where  she  imagined  that  the  Virgin  Mary 
appeared  to  her,  and  bid  her  found  an  order 
in  honour  of  her  own  immaculate  conception . 
This  she  did  in  1484,  and  Pope  Innocent 
VIII.  confirmed  the  order  in  1489,  and 
granted  them  permission  to  follow  the  rule 
of  the  Cistercians.  The  second  convent  of 
the  order  was  founded  in  the  year  1507,  at 
Torrigo,  in  the  diocese  of  Toledo,  which 
produced  seven  others,  the  first  of  which 
was  at  Madrid.  This  order  passed  into 
Italy,  and  got  footing  in  Home  and  Milan. 
In  the  reign  of  Louis  XIV.,  king  of  France, 
the  Clarisses  of  the  suburb  of  St.  Germain, 
at  Paris,  embraced  the  order  of  the  Concep- 
tion. These  religious,  besides  the  grand 
ofiice  of  the  Franciscans,  recite  on  Sundays 
and  holy-days  a  lesser  office,  called  the 
office  of  the  CJonception  of  the  Holy  Virgin. 

CONCEPTION,  MIRACULOUS.  The 
production  of  the  human  nature  of  the 
Son  of  God  out  of  the  ordinary  course  of 


222 


CONCERNING 


generation,  by  tlie  power  of  the  Holy  Ghost. 
(St.  Matt.  i.  18,  25.) 

"  It  were  not  difficult  to  show  that  the 
miraculous  conception,  once  admitted,  na- 
turally brings  after  it  the  great  doctrines 
of  the  incarnation  and  the  atonement.  The 
miraculous  conception  of  our  Lord  evidently 
implies  some  higher  purpose  of  His  comim; 
than  the  mere  business  of  a  teacher.  Tae 
business  of  a  teacher  might  have  been  per- 
formed by  a  mere  man,  enlightened  by  the 
prophetic  spirit.  For  whatever  instruction 
men  have  the  capacity  to  receive,  a  man 
might  have  been  made  the  instrument  to 
convey.  Had  teaching,  therefore,  been  the 
sole  purpose  of  our  Saviour's  coming,  a  mere 
man  might  have  done  the  whole  business,  and 
the  supernatural  conception  had  been  an 
■unnecessary  miracle.  He,  therefore,  who 
came  in  this  miraculous  way,  came  upon 
some  higher  business,  to  which  a  mere  man 
was  unequal.  He  came  to  be  made  a  sin- 
offering  for  us,  that  we  might  be  made  the 
righteousness  of  God  in  Him." — Bp.  Sorsley. 
And  see  especially  sermon  by  J.  H.  Nevrman 
for  Christmas  Day  in  vol.  ii.  of  Parochial 
■and  Plain  Sermons. 

CONCERNING  THE  SERVICE  OP 
THE  CHURCH.  The  explanatory  intro- 
duction to,  originally  the  Preface,  of  the 
Prayer  Book.  It  is  supposed  to  have  been 
written  by  Cranmer,  and  was  inserted  in  its 
present  position  in  1661,  when  the  Preface 
was  added.  It  is  derived  chiefly  from  the 
Reformed  Roman  Breviary  of  Quignonez. 
(See  Breviary.') 

CONCLAVE.  The  place  where  the  car- 
dinals meet  for  the  choosing  of  a  new  pope : 
the  assembly  itself  is  also  called  by  this 
name,  and  it  depends  upon  the  members 
themselves  to  choose  the  place,  although  for 
some  time  the  Vatican  has  been  constantly 
used.  Here  they  erect,  in  a  large  apartment, 
as  many  cells  of  deal  wood  as  there  are 
cardinals,  with  lodges  and  places  for  the  con- 
iclavists,  who  shut  themselves  in  to  wait  and 
serve  the  cardinals.  These  little  chambers 
have  their  numbers,  and  are  drawn  by  lot, 
so  that  it  often  happens  that  cardinals  of 
different  factions  lodge  near  one  another. 

CONCORDANCE,  a  dictionary  or  index 
io  the  Bible,  wherein  all  the  leading  words 
are  ranged  alphabetically,,  and  the  books, 
•chapters,  and  verses  wherein  they  occur, 
referred  to,  to  assist  in  finding  out  passages, 
.fi.nd  comparing  the  several  significations  of 
the  same  word.  I.  The  earliest  attempt  at 
a  Concordance  is  the  collection  of  parallel 
passages  in  the  margin  of  the  5th  volume  of 
ithe  Complatensian  Polyglot.  Hugo  de  St. 
Caro,  or  Cardinal  Hugo,  who  is  said  to  have 
employed  500  monks,  compiled  a  Concord- 
ance of  the  Vulgate  in  the  middle  of  the 
thirteenth  century.  The  earliest  Concordance 


CONCOKDAT 

of  the  Hebrew  Text  is  by  Rabbi  Mordecai 
Nathan(Venice,1523);  that  of  Calasio  (1621) 
is  the  fullest ;  but  there  are  many  others 
by  Buxtorf,  Taylor,  Noldius,  &c.  Kircher 
and  Tromm  compiled  a,  Concordance  of  the 
Septuagint :  Williams  (1767) ;  and  Schmidt 
(a  very  beautiful  12mo  edition  of  which 
was  edited  by  Mr.  Greenfield  in  1830) ;  and 
several  others  of  the  Greek  New  Testament. 

n.  The  first  English  Concordance  to  the 
New  Testament  was  "  imprinted  by  Thos. 
Gybson"  before  1540.  The  first  to  the 
entire  Bible  was  pubUshed  by  John  Merbeck, 
Merbecke,  or  Marbeok,  the  celebrated  Eng- 
lish musician,  in  1550. 

But  of  English  Concordances,  Cruden's  is 
the  best  known  and  is  valued  by  every  bibU- 
cal  student.  An  excellent  Concordance  was 
published  by  the  S.P.C.K.  in  1859,  including 
a  Concordance  to  the  apocryphal  books  and  to 
the  Prayer  Book  version  of  the  Psalter.  [H.] 

CONCORDAT.  An  agreement  between 
the  See  of  Rome  and  any  foreign  govern- 
ment, by  which  the  discipline  of  the  clergy, 
and  management  and  disposal  of  churches 
and  benefices  are  regulated.  The  Con- 
cordat of  Worms,  A.B.  1122,  between  the 
Emperor  Henry  and  Pope  Calixtus  II., 
regulated  the  election  of  bishops  and  abbots, 
each  side  making  concessions.  The  Ger- 
manic Concordat,  A.D.1448,made  between  the 
Emperor  Frederick  III.  and  Pope  Nicholas  V., 
and  confirmed  by  Clement  VIII.  and  Gregory 
XIII.,  comprehended  four  parts ;  in  the 
first  of  which  the  pope  reserved  to  himself 
the  confemng  of  all  vacant  benefices  at 
Rome,  and  100  days'  journey  from  it,  of 
whatever  degree,  either  secular  or  regular, 
which  before  went  by  election,  without 
exception  of  cardinals  or  other  officers  of  the 
holy  see.  The  second  concerns  the  elections 
that  are  to  be  confimied  by  the  pope,  with 
regard  to  metropolitans,  bishops,  &c.  The 
third  deals  vrith  livings  that  are  successively 
given  by  the  popes  and  their  proper  patrons ; 
that  the  pope  has  the  privilege  to  confer 
both  secular  and  regular  livings,  for  the 
months  of  January,  March,  May,  July, 
September,  November;  and  the  bishop  or 
archbishop  within  the  district  of  their  dio- 
ceses during  the  other  months.  The  fourth 
and  last  part  speaks  of  the  annates  or  first- 
fruit.«,  after  the  death  or  removal  of  the 
incumbent.  In  a.d.  1516  an  agreement 
was  made  between  Francis  I.  of  Prance  and 
Pope  Leo  X.,  which  was  called  a  concordat ; 
and  by  which  the  pragmatic  sanction  was 
abrogated  (see  Pragmatic  Sanction).  A 
concordat  was  agreed  upon  in  a.d.  1801, 
between  Buonaparte  and  Cardinal  Consalvi, 
acting  in  the  name  of  Pope  Pius  VII.,  by 
which  the  head  of  the  state  had  the  nomina- 
tion to  the  vacant  sees,  but  the  pope  was  to 
confer  canonical  institution,  the  clergy  were 


CONDIGNITY 

subjected  to  tlie  civil  power,  and  all  im- 
.munities  were  abolished.  Another  concordat 
was  made  between  Louis  XVIIf.  and  Pius 
VII.,  in  A.D.  1817,  with  regard  to  the  re- 
construction of  dioceses. — Stubbs'  Mosheim, 
vol.  ii.  pp.  331,  376 :  iii.  pp.  536,  545 ; 
MUman's  Lat.  Christ,  iii.  p.  215  ;  Burnet's 
Hist.  Ileform.  iii.  13. 

CONDiaNITY  and  CONGRUITY. 
Terms  used  by  the  schoolmen  to  express 
their  peculiar  opinions  relative  to  human 
merit  and  deserving.  The  Scotisfs  maintain 
that  it  is  possible  for  man  in  his  natural 
state  so  to  live  as  to  deserve  the  grace  of 
God,  by  which  he  may  be  enabled  to  obtain 
salvation;  this  natural  fitness  (congruitas) 
for  grace,  being  such  as  to  oblige  the  Deity 
to  grant  it.  Such  is  the  merit  of  congruity. 
The  Thomists,  on  the  other  hand,  contend 
that  man,  by  the  divine  assistance,  is 
capable  of  so  living  as  to  merit  eternal  life, 
to  be  worthy  (condignus)  of  it  in  the  sight 
of  God.  In  this  hypothesis,  the  question  of 
previous  preparation  for  the  grace  which 
enables  him  to  be  worthy,  is  not  introduced. 
This  is  the  m^rit  of  condignity. 

Article  XIII.  "  Works  done  before  the 
grace  of  Christ,  and  the  inspiration  of  his 
Spirit,  are  not  pleasant  to  God,  forasmuch 
as  they  spring  not  of  faith  in  Jesus  Christ, 
neither  do  they  make  men  meet  to  I'eceive 
grace,  or  (as  the  school-authors  say)  desei"ve 
grace  of  congruity :  yea,  rather,  for  that 
they  are  not  done  as  God  hath  willed  and 
commanded  them  to  be  done,  we  doubt  not 
but  they  have  the  nature  of  sin." 

CONDUCT.  A  name  given  to  chaplains 
of  colleges  in  the  university  of  Cambridge 
and  at  Eton ;  meaning  a  "  Capellanus  con- 
ductitius "     (See  Chaplain^ 

CONDITIONAL  BAPTISM.  The  ad- 
ministration of  the  rite  of  baptism,  when 
it  has  not  been  assured  that  it  has  been 
before  properly  perfoimed.  Mention  is 
made  of  this  in  the  statutes  of  St.  Boniface 
(Martene,  de  Bit.  Ant.  i.  IsvL  10).  The 
fourth  rubric  (Priv.  Bapt.)  directs  public 
certification  by  the  priest  of  the  private 
baptism  by  himself,  or  examination  by  him 
into  the  matter  if  another  had  baptized. 
Up  to  1604  the  latter  only  was  mentioned 
in  the  rubric.  The  examination  is  confined 
to  two  points,  (a)  evidence  of  the  fact  of 
laaptism;  (fi)  evidence  of  baptism  in  due 
^orm,  by  water  and  in  the  name  of  the  Holy 
Trinity.  If  such  evidence  is  not  forthcoming, 
tthen  only  is  conditional  re-baptism  allowed. 

CONPALON,  or  GONFALON,  Society 
of  the.  So  called  from  the  Gonfalon,  or 
banner,  bearing  the  -figure  of  the  Virgin 
Mary,  which  was  their  ensign. — JRaynaldus. 
A  confraternity  of  seculars  in  the  Church  of 
Rome,  called  penitents,  established  first  of 
Jill  by  some  Roman  citizens  in  1267:  and 


CONFESSION 


223 


confirmed  by  Pope  Gregory  XIII.  in  157G. 
Henry  III.  began  one  at  Paris  in  1583,  .and 
himself  assisted  in  the  habit  of  a  penitent, 
at  a  procession  wherein  the  cardinal  of  Guise 
carried  the  cross,  and  his  brother  the  duke 
of  Mayenne  was  master  of  the  ceremonies. 

CONFERENCES.     (See  Congress.) 

CONFERENCE,  DIOCESAN.  (See  Con- 
gress, ad  fin.,  II.) 

CONFERENCES,  DIOCESAN,  CEN- 
TRAL CO  UNCIL'OF.     (See  Congress,  III.) 

CONFESSION."  (See  Auricular  Con- 
fession.) The  verbal  acknowledgment  of 
sin.  The  article  is  thus  divided.  I.  Early 
ideas  about  confession.  II.  The  doctrine  of 
the  Church  of  England.  III.  Forms  of 
confession. 

I.  In  the  primitive  Church,  no  other  con- 
fession of  sins  was  required  in  order  to 
receive  baptism  thau  -the  general  renuncia- 
tion of  the  devil  and  all  his  works. 

Nor  did  the  Church  lay  any  obligation 
on  the  consciences  of  men,  to  make  either 
public  or  private  confession  of  their  sins  to 
any  but  God,  in  order  to  qualify  them  for 
Holy  Communion.  The  confessions  of  the 
primitive  Christians  were  all  voluntary,  and 
not  imposed  upon  them  by  any  laws  of  the 
Church.  Notwithstanding  which  it  must 
be  owned,  that  private  confession,  though 
not  absolutely  required,  yet  was  allowed 
and  encouraged  by  the  ancients,  in  some 
cases,  and  ,  upon  special  occasions.  For, 
first,  they  advised  men,  in  case  of  lesser 
sins,  to  make  confession  mutually  to  each 
other,  that  they  might  have  each  other's 
prayers  and  assistance,  according  to  the 
advice  of  St.  James,  "  Confess  your  faults 
one  to  another,  and  pray  for  one  another, 
that  ye  may  be  healed."  Which,  though 
it  be  produced  by  the  Romanists  in  favour 
of  auricular  confession  to  a  pri'esi,  yet  the 
ancients  understood  it  only  as  a  direction  to 
Christians  to  confess  mutually  to  each  other. 
(See  Chrys.  Horn,  xxviii.  in  1  Cor.  :  Horn. 
viii.  de  Psenitent.)  2.  Incase  of  injuries  done 
to  any  private  person,  it  was  expected  that 
the  offender  should  make  a  private  con- 
fession of  his  fault  to  the  person  injured. 
3.  St.  Cyprian  says  that  penitents  opened 
their  minds  to  God's  priests ;  not  to  one 
alone,  but  before  the  whole  consistory.  {De 
Lapsis ;  see  also  Tertul.  de  Penitent,  c.  10.) 
But;  sometimes  when  men  were  under  any 
perplexities  of  mind,  or  troubles  of  con- 
science, this  was  a  case  in  which  they  were 
directed  to  have  recourse  to  some  pastor, 
and  to  take  his  counsel  and  advice.  4.  Ori- 
gen  (flbm.  ii.  in  Ps.  xxxvii.)  gives  another 
reason  for  confessing  private  sins  to  the 
priest,  which  is,  that  he  was  the  fittest  judge 
v?hen  it  was  proper  to  do  ijublic  penance  for 
private  offences.  (See  Penitentiary.) — 
Bingham,  bk.  xv,  ch.  viii.  §  6. 


224 


CONFESSION 


All  that  can  plainly  lie  deduced  from  the 
scriptural  doctrine  concerninj;  confession  is 
this,  that,  in  common  or  ordinary  sins,  we 
are  to  acknowledge  them  before  Almighty 
God,  either  particularly  in  our  private,  or 
generally  in  our  public  devotion  ;  but  as  for 
some  sins  of  a  more  extraordinary  kind,  the 
heinousness    whereof    ordinary    Christians 
may  not  be  sufficiently  apprized  of,  or  which 
may  be  attended  with  such  nice  circum- 
stances as  perplex  their  consciences,  here 
resort  is  proper  to  be  made  to  the  ministers 
of  the  Church,  who,  as  physicians  of  the 
soul,   are  best  able  to   advise   the    fittest 
remedies  upon  such  uncommon  emergencies. 
Matters  of  this  kind  stood  within   these 
limits  for  a  considerable  time  after  the  first 
propagating  of  the  gospel ;  but,  during  the 
piety  of  very  early  times,  another  sort  of 
confession  came  in  use,  for  it  having  been 
the    practice    for    excommunicates,    before 
their  reception  into  the  Church,  to  make  a 
solemn  confession  of  their  faults  before  the 
whole  congregation,  some  persons  who  had 
fallen   into   a  great   sin,  though  they  had 
never  been  censured  for  it,  thought  it  a  part 
of  their  duty  to  take  upon  themselves  a 
public  shame  for  it,  by  discovering  it  to  the 
whole  congregation  they  were  members  of, 
and  to  desire  their  prayers  to  God  for  their 
pardon.     Some  difficulties  and  inconvenience 
arising  from  this  practice,  about  the  year 
360,  the  office  of  a  public  penitentiary  in 
the  Greek  Church  began,  who  was  to  be  a 
presbyter  of  good  conversation,  prudent,  and 
one  who  could  keep  a  secret ;  to  whom  those 
who  were  lapsed  into  any  greater  sin  might 
confess  it ;  and  he,  according  to  his  discre- 
tion, was  to  enjoin  a  penance  for  it.    But 
still  there  was  no  command  for  all  people  to 
confess  their  sins  to  this  presbyter.     In  the 
Latin  Church,  the  practice  of  public  con- 
fession to  the  whole  congregation  continued 
100  years  longer,  viz.  till  the  time  of  I'ope 
Leo,  which  was  about  the  year  450,  who 
by  an  injunction  of  his,  abrogated  it;  and 
after  some  time,  the  Greek  Church  began  to 
grow  weary  of  this  private  confession  to  a 
penitentiary,   and  so  laid  it  aside.      But 
whilst  private  confession  to  ministers  was 
practised,  in  some  of  the  earlier  ages  of  the 
Church,  recourse  was  had  to  them  only  as 
spiritual    physicians    and    counsellors,    as 
appears  by  many    passages  of   antiquity. 
By  the  Lateran  Council,  a.d.  1215,  every 
person,  of  each  sex,  was  obliged  once  in  a 
year  to  confess  to  the  minister  of  his  parish, 
the    sins    which    he    had  been  guilty  of. 
Auricular  confession  to  the  priest  being  thus 
established,  some  of  the  school  divines  of 
the  Roman   Church  carried  it  to  further 
lengths,  making  it  to  be  an  article  of  faith  ; 
to  be  received  by  the  priest,  not  ministerially, 
but   judicial!}'    and    authoritatively ;   that 


CONFESSION 

every  single  sin  must  be  discovered  to  them 
with  all  its  aggravating  circumstances,  &c. 
All  which  tyranny  over  men's  coEScionces, 
and  diving  into  the  secrets  of  families  and 
governments,  was  confirmed  by  the  Council 
of  Trent. 

It  appears  then  certain  that  before  the 
time  when  Innocent  III.,  in  1215,  promul- 
gated the  celebrated  21st  Canon,  "  Omnis 
utriusque  sexus"  above  referred  to,  private 
confession  was  not  deemed  a  necessity,  but 
that  afterwards  it  was.  Local  synods,  as. 
for  instance  that  of  Lambeth,  a.d.  1378,  re- 
imposed  the  canon  in  a  stiU  stricter  form, 
and  it  became  generally  taught  that  con- 
fession was  part  of  a  sacrament  which  is 
generally  necessary  to  salvation.  "  This," 
says  Jeremy  Taylor,  "  the  Church  of  Eome 
now  affirms,  and  the  Church  of  England 
denies;  and  complains  sadly  that  command- 
ments of  men  are  changed  into  the  doctrines 
of  God  by  a  pharisaical  empire,  and  super- 
stition." (Works,  vol.  xi.,  Heber's  ed.  p.  11.) 
"  We  find,"  Hooker  sums  up,  "  the  use  of 
confession,  especially  public,  allowed  of  by 
the  Fathers,  but  that  extreme  and  rigorous 
necessity  of  auricular  and  private  confession 
which  is  at  this  day  so  mightily  upheld  by 
the  Church  of  Home  we  find  not." — Ecc. 
Pol.  bk.  vi.,  iv.  13. 

II.  The  doctrine  of  the  Church  of  England 
on  this  point  is  shown  in  two  places  in  the 
Prayer  Book. 

1.  The  Warning  for  the  Celelraiion  of 
the  Holy  Communion :  "  Because  it  is 
requisite  that  no  man  should  come  to  the 
holy  communion  but  with  a  full  faith  in  God's 
mercy,  and  with  a  quiet  conscience ;  there- 
fore, if  there  be-any  of  you  who  by  this  means 
cannot  quiet  his  own  conscience  therein, 
but  requiretli  further  comfort  or  counsel, 
let  him  come  to  me,  or  to  some  other  dis- 
creet and  learned  minister  of  God's  word, 
and  open  his  grief,  that  by  the  ministration 
of  God's  holy  word  he  may  receive  the 
benefit  of  absolution,  together  with  ghostly 
counsel  and  advice  to  the  quieting  of  his 
conscience,  and  avoiding  of  all  scruple  and 
doubtfulnes."  (2).  Bubric,  in  the  Office  for 
the  Visitation  of  the  Sick :  "  Here  shall  the 
sick  person  be  moved  to  make  a  special 
confession  of  his  sins,  if  he  feel  his  con- 
science troubled  with  any  weighty  matter. 
After  which  confession,  the  priest  shall 
absolve  him  (if  he  humbly  and  heartily 
desire  it)  after  this  sort."  By  the  113th 
canon,  empowering  ministers  to  prevent 
offences  at  the  court  of  visitation,  it  is  pro- 
vided that  "if  any  man  confess  his  secret 
and  hidden  sins  to  the  minister,  for  the 
unburdening  of  his  conscience,  and  to  re- 
ceive spiritual  consolation  and  ease  of  mind 
from  him,  he  shall  not  in  anywise  be  bound 
by  this  constitution,  but  is  strictly  charged 


COKPESSION 

■and  admonished  that  he  do  not  at  any  time 
reveal  and  make  known  to  any  person 
■^vhatsoever,  any  crime  or  offence  so  com- 
mitted to  his  trust  and  secrecy  (except 
they  be  such  crimes  as,  by  the  laws  of  this 
realm,  his  own  life  may  be  called  in  question 
for  concealing  the  same),  under  pain  of 
■irregularity."  The  113  th  canon  also  refers 
to  the  subject,  enjoining  secrecy  of  the 
minister  in  respect  to  confessions  made  to 
him.  In  the  2nd  part  of  the  Homily  of 
Repentance  the  words  used  in  the  "Warning 
for  Holy  Communion  "  are  repeated,  and  en- 
larged upon.  "As  forprivate  confession,"  says 
Bishop  Jewel,  "  abuses  and  en-ors  set  apart, 
■we  condemn  it  not,  but  leave  it  at  liberty." 

HI.  Forms  of  confession  are  generally 
■to  be  met  with  in  the  liturgies  of  antiquity, 
but  a  form  superior,  or  equal,  to  that  in  our 
•o-wn,  called  the  "  General  Confession,"  is 
nowhere  to  be  found.  Like  the  prayer 
■which  Jesus  taught  us,  though  concise,  it 
is  comprehensive  and  full ;  though  conceived 
in  general  terms,  yet  at  the  same  time  it  is 
so  particular,  that  it  includes  every  kind 
of  sin. 

The  General  Confession  with  the  Abso- 
iution,  was  first  inserted  in  the  Morning 
and  Evening  Prayer,  by  the  Second  Book 
of  King  Edward  VI. 

A  Confession  was  formerly  recited  in  the 
ofBce  for  the  first  hour  of  the  morning, 
according  to  the  rites  of  the  English 
Churches.  It  occurred  in  the  course  of 
prayers  which  came  at  the  end  of  the 
•service :  and  had  this  arrangement  been 
regarded  by  the  reformers,  the  Confession 
and  Absolution  would  now  be  placed  imme- 
diately before  the  collect  for  the  day.  "  There 
■were,  however,  good  reasons  for  placing  the 
Confession  at  the  beginning  of  the  office. 
■Christian  humility  would  naturally  induce 
us  to  approach  the  infinitely  holy  God  with 
a  confession  of  our  sinfulness  and  unworthi- 
ness ;  and  this  position  of  the  Confession  is 
justified  by  the  practice  of  the  Eastern 
Church  in  the  time  of  Basil,  who  observes 
that  the  people  all  confessed  their  sins  with 
great  contrition,  at  the  beginning  of  the 
nocturnal  service,  and  before  the  psalmody 
and  lessons  commenced." — Palmer,  i.  104. 
((See  Breviary.) 

At  the  time  of  the  review  of  the  liturgy, 
A.D.  1661,  it  was  objected  by  the  Pres- 
byterian clergy  against  this  Confession, 
i;hat  there  was  no  preparatory  prayer  for 
God's  assistance  and  acceptance ;  and  that 
it  was  defective  in  not  clearly  expressing 
'"original  sin,"  nor  enumerating  actual  sins 
with  then-  aggravations.  To  which  it  was 
■answered  by  the  Episcopalian  commission- 
•ers,  that  the  preparatory  sentences,  and 
ihe  preceding  exhortation,  amply  supplied 
this;  and   that  the  form  being  so  general 


CONFESSIONS 


225 


is  rather  a  perfection  than  a  defect,  as  in 
such  case  all  may  join,  since  in  many 
things  we  offend  all.  And  as  to  the  notice 
of  original  sin,  they  conceived  that  to  be 
sufficiently  acknowledged  in  the  sentence 
(with  others,  as  the  "devices  and  desires  of 
our  own  hearts,"  &c.),  "  and  there  is  no 
health  in  us."  With  respect  to  the  general 
terms  used  throughout  the  Common  Prayer 
Book,  dissenters  have  complained  of  such 
expressions  as,  "  that  we  may  do  God's 
will" — "that  we  may  be  kept' from  all 
evil,"  &c. ;  to  which  the  Episcopalians  pro- 
perly remark,  "  these  are  almost  the  very 
terms  in  the  Lord's  Prayer ;  so  that  they 
must  reform  that,  before  they  can  pretend 
to  amend  our  liturgy  in  these  petitions." 

We  may  judge  how  far  the  objections  are 
worthy  of  notice,  by  the  form  composed  by 
Calvin  himself,  and  used  by  the  French 
reformed  Churches,  which  begins,  "  0  Lord 
God,  Eternal  and  Almighty  Father,  we  ac- 
knowledge and  confess  that  we  are  miserable 
sinners  .  . .  but  yet,  0  Lord,  we  are  heartily 
sorry,"  &c. 

It  appears,  indeed,  that  our  form  of  confes- 
sion was  in  great  measure  suggested  by  this 
form,  or  rather  by  the  translation  of  it 
made  by  Valerandus  PoUanus,  for  the  re- 
formed congregation  of  Strasburg.  (See 
Laurence's  Bampton  Lectures.) 

The  Confession  in  the  Holy  Communion 
OfBce  is  partly  taken  from  Hermann's 
Consultation,  partly  from  the  ancient  Use. 
The  rubric  in  the  "  Order  of  Communion  " 
of  1549  ran,  "Then  shall  a  general  con- 
fession be  made  in  the  name  of  all  those 
who  are  minded  to  receive  the  Holy  Com- 
munion, either  by  one  of  them,  or  else  by 
one  of  the  ministers,  or  by  the  priest 
himself."  It  continued  so  till  1662,  when 
an  objection  was  made  at  the  Savoy  Con- 
ference against  public  prayer  being  read  by 
a  layman,  and  the  rubric  was  altered  to 
its  present  form.     (See  Liturgy.) 

CONFESSIONS  OP  FAITH.  The 
systems  of  theology  drawn  up  by  foreign 
reformers  were  frequently  called  Confes- 
sions of  Faith.  The  following  are  the 
Confessions  of  the  different  Churches. 

1.  That  of  the  Greek  Church,  entitled 
"  The  Confessions  of  the  True  and  Genuine 
Faith,"  which  was  presented  to  Mohammed 
II.,  in  1453,  but  whicli  gave  place  to  the 
"  Orthodox  Confession  of  the  Catholic  and 
Apostolic  Greek  Church,"  composed  by 
Mogila,  metropolitan  of  Kiev,  in  Russia, 
and  approved  in  1643,  with  great  solemn- 
ity, by  the  patriarchs  of  Constantinople, 
Alexandria,  Antioch,  and  Jerusalem.  It 
contains  the  standard  of  the  principles  of 
the  Russian  Greek  Church.  See  Palmers 
Collection  of  Russian  Symbolical  Books  and 
Neale's  Hist,  of  the  Oreek  Church. 

Q 


226 


CONFESSION 


2.  The  Church  of  Rome,  though  she  has 
always  received  the  Apostles',  Nicene,  and 
Athanasian  Creeds,  had  no  fixed  public 
and  authoritative  symbol  till  the  Council 
of  Trent.  A  summary  of  the  doctrines 
contained  in  the  canons  of  that  council  is 
given  in  the  creed  published  by  Pius  IV. 
(1564)  in  the  form  of  a  bull.  It  is  intro- 
duced by  the  Nicene  Creed,  to  which  it 
adds  twelve  articles,  comprising  those  doc- 
trines which  the  Church  of  Kome  finally 
adopted  after  her  controversies  with  the 
Reformers.  (See  Creed  of  Pope  Pius 
IV.) 

3.  The  Lutherans  call  their  standard 
books  of  faith  and  discipline,  "  Libri  Sym- 
bolici  EcclesicB  Evangelicas."  They  contain 
the  three  creeds  above  mentioned,  the 
Augsburg  Confession,  the  Apology  for  that 
Confession  by  Melanchthon,  the  Articles  of 
Smalcald,  drawn  up  by  Luther;  the  Cate- 
chisms of  Luther  ;  and,  in  many  churches, 
the  form  of  Concord,  or  Book  of  Torgau. 
The  Saxon  (composed  by  Melanchthon), 
Wurtemberg,  Suabian,  Pomeranian,  Mans- 
feldtian,  and  Copenhagen  Confessions  agree 
in  general  with  the  symbolical  books  of  the 
Lutherans,  but  are  of  authority  only  in  the 
countries  from  which  they  are  respectively 
called.     (See  Augsburg  Confession.) 

4.  The  Confessions  of  the  Calvinistic 
Churches  are  numerous.  The  following 
are  the  principal : — (1.)  The  Helvetic 
Confessions  are  three — that  of  Basle,  1530 ; 
the  Summary  and  Confession  of  the  Hel- 
vetic Churches,  1536 ;  and  the  "  Expositio 
Simplex,"  &c.,  1566,  ascribed  to  Bullinger. 
(2.)  The  Tetrapohtan  Confession,  1531,— 
which  derives  its  name  from  the  four  cities 
of  Strasburg,  Constance,  Memmingen,  and 
Lindau,  by  the  deputies  of  vehich  it  was 
signed, — is  attributed  to  Bucer.  (3.)  The 
Palatine  or  Heidelberg  Confession,  framed 
by  order  of  the  Elector  Palatine  John 
Casimir,  1575.  (4.)  The  Confession  of  the 
Gallic  Churches,  accepted  at  the  first  synod 
of  the  Reformed,  held  at  Paris,  1559.  (5.) 
The  Confession  of  the  Reformed  Churches 
in  Belgium,  drawn  up  in  1559,  and  approved 
in  1561.  (6.)  The  Confession  of  Faith  of 
Ihe  Kirk  of  Scotland,  which  was  that 
composed  by  the  assembly  at  Westminster, 
and  was  received  as  the  standard  of  the 
Scotch  national  faith  in  1690.  See  Har- 
mony  of  Confessions,  or  the  Faith  of  Chris- 
tian and  Reformed  Cliurches  1643 ;  and 
Sylloge  Confessionum  sub  tempus  Befor- 
•mandm  Ecclesim,  Oxon.  1804. 

CONFESSION  OP  FAITH,  "WEST- 
MINSTER. The  Confession  of  Faith 
which  was  drawn  up  by  the  Puritans  in 
England,  and  which  is  adopted  by  the 
iScottish  establishment.  The  ordinance 
under  which  the  assembly  which  drew  up 


CONFESSION 

this  Confession  sat  at  Westminster  com- 
mences thus : 

"An  Ordinance  of  the  Lords  and  Commons 
assembled  in  Parliament,  for  the  calling  of 
an  Assembly  of  learned  and  godly  Divines, 
and  others,  to  be  consulted  with  by  the 
Parliament,  for  the  settling  of  the  govern- 
ment and  liturgy  of  the  Church  of  England  j 
and  for  vindicating  and  clearing  of  the 
doctrine  of  the  said  Church  from  false 
aspersions  and  interpretations.  June  12, 
1643."  The  assembly  contained  so  many 
Presbyterians,  that  the  Episcopalians  and 
Independents  who  had  been  summoned  were 
utterly  powerless  on  a  division.  The  chief 
point  was  the  extirpation  of  Popery  and 
Prelacy.  The  Confession  consisted  of  thirty- 
three  chapters,  based  upon  the  Calvinistie 
Confessions  on  the  continent. 

The  Westminster  Confession  of  Faith  was 
approved  by  the  General  Assembly  of  the 
Kirk  of  Scotland,  on  the  27th  of  August, 
1647,  sess.  23,  and  was  ratified  by  Act  of 
the  Scottish  Parliament,  7th  February, 
1649.     See  next  article. 

CONFESSION 'OF  FAITH  OF  THE 
KIRK  OF  SCOTLAND,  or  THE  NA- 
TIONAL COVENANT.  "  Subscribed 
at  first  by  the  King's  Majesty,  and  his 
Household,  in  the  Year  1580 ;  thereafter  by 
persons  of  all  ranks  in  the  year  1581,  by 
ordinance  of  the  Lords  of  secret  council,  and 
acts  cf  the  General  Assembly;  subscribed 
again  by  all  sorts  of  persons  in  the  year 
1590,  by  a  new  oidinance  of  council,  at  the 
desire  of  the  General  Assembly:  with,  a 
general  bond  for  the  maintaining  of  the  true 
Christian  religion,  and  the  King's  person;, 
and,  together  with  a  resolution  and  promise, 
for  the  causes  after  expressed,  to  maintain 
the  true  religion,  and  the  King's  Majesty, 
according  to  the  foresaid  Confession  and  acts- 
of  Parliament,  subscribed  by  Barons,  Nobles, 
Gentlemen,  Burgesses,  Ministers,  and  Com- 
mons, in  the  year  1638 :  approven  by  the 
General  Assembly  1638  and  1639 ;  and 
subscribed  again  by  persons  of  all  ranks  and 
qualities  in  the  year  1639,  by  an  ordinance 
of  council,  upon  the  supplication  of  the 
General  Assembly,  and  act  of  the  General 
Assembly,  ratified  by  an  act  of  Parliament 
1640 ;  and  subscribed  by  King  Charles  II. 
at  Spey,  June  23,  1650,  and  Scoon,  January 
1,  1651."  The  Confession  contains  severe 
denunciations  against  "  all  contrary  religion 
and  doctrine ;  but  chiefly  all  kind  of 
Papistry  in  general  and  particular  heads,, 
even  as  they  are  now  damned  and  confuted 
by  the  Word  of  God,  and  Kirk  of  Scotland." 
The  corruptions  of  the  "  Roman  Antichrist," 
his  "  five  bastard  Sacraments ; "  his  "  absolute 
necessity  of  baptism ; "  his  "  blasphemous- 
opinion  of  transubstantiation,  or  real 
presence  of  Christ's  body  in  the  element ; "" 


CONFESSION 

his  "  blasphemous  litany ; "  his  "  manifold 
orders ;  "  liis  "  three  solemn  vows,  with 
shavellings  of  sundry  sorts,"  &c.,  &c.;  are 
condemned.  All  Papists  and  priests,  to- 
gether with  the  spreaders  and  makers  of 
erroneous  books  and  libels  (the  term  in- 
cluding all  except  those  that  were  in  ac- 
cordance with  the  covenant),  were  to  be 
punished  "  with  manifold  civil  and  ecclesi- 
astical pains,  as  adversaries  to  God's  true 
religion."  Those  who  "went  to  crosses," 
or  observed  the  "  festival  days  of  saints," 
were  to  be  punished  as  idolaters.  The 
Confession  then  goes  on  to  order  that 
"  none  shall  be  reputed  as  loyal  and  faithful 
subjects  to  our  sovereign  Lord,  or  his 
authority,  but  be  punishable  as  rebellers, 
and  gainstanders  of  the  same,  who  shall  not 
give  their  confession,  and  make  their  pro- 
fession of  the  said  true  religion."  The 
"  National  Covenant "  closes  with  a  very 
long  oath,  taken  "  before  God,  His  angels, 
and  the  world" — called  in  the  Act  of 
Assembly  "  our  great  oath." 

It  is  evident  that  this  was  aimed  against 
the  Church  of  England  as  well  as  against 
the  Church  of  Kome.  Together  with  the 
Solemn  League  and  Covenant,  it  is  bound 
up  with  and  added  to  the  Westminster 
Confession  of  Faith,  and  published  by 
authority  of  the  Scottish  Establishment. 
But  it  has  been  stated,  on  good  authority, 
that  no  licentiate  or  minister  of  the  Scottish 
Establishment  has  signed  or  been  asked 
to  sign  this,  or  the  Solemn  League  and 
Covenant,  for  the  last  150  years.  This  does 
not,  however,  exonerate  the  religious  com- 
munity which  still  publishes  these  docu- 
ments authoritatively  from  the  charge  of 
intolerance ;  and  all  classes  of  Episcopalians, 
including  of  course  the  Church  of  England, 
are  involved  in  the  fearful  anathemas  put 
forth  by  the  Covenanters. 

CONFESSION  OF  AUGSBUEG,  or 
AUGUSTAN  CONFESSION.  A  con- 
fession of  faith,  drawn  up  by  Melanchthon, 
and  presented  by  him  and  Luther  to  the 
emperor  Charles  Y.  at  Augsburg,  in  the 
year  1530.  It  was  divided  into  two  parts, 
and  was  designed  to  support  all  the  points 
of  the  Lutheran  reformation,  and  to  show 
the  heterodoxy  of  the  Church  of  Rome. — 
Maimbourg,  Hist,  du  Lutlieranisme. 

It  was  signed  by  the  Elector  of  Saxony, 
and  his  eldest  son,  by  the  Marquis  of 
Brandenburg,  by  the  Landgrave  of  Hesse, 
the  Prince  of  Ilainault,  and  the  republics  of 
Nuremberg  and  Eutiingua.  It  was  argued 
before  the  emperor  Charles  V.,  but  rejected ; 
the  Boman  Catholics  having  a  majority  of 
votes  in  the  council.  This  was  followed  by 
a  conference  between  seven  deputies  of  each 
party;  in  which,  Luther  being  absent, 
Melanchthon,  by  his  mollifying  explanations. 


CONFUIMATION 


227 


brought  both  sides  to  an  agreement  in 
relation  to  fifteen  of  the  lirst  twenty-one 
articles.  But  the  conference  broke  up  with- 
out adjusting  all  the  differences  between 
them.     (See  Atigshurg  Confession^ 

CONFESSIONAL.  (See  Confession  and 
Auricular  Confession.)  An  enclosed  seat 
or  closet  of  wood  in  Roman  churches  where 
penitents  make  confession  to  the  priests. 
There  is  none  older  than  the  15th  century  ; 
no  example  is  known  of  the  confessional 
forming  part  of  the  fabric  of  a  church. 

CONFESSOR.  I.  A  name  given  to 
those  who  confessed  the  doctrine  of  Christ 
before  heathen  or  persecuting  judges ;  or  to 
those  who  firmly  endured  punishment  for 
defending  the  faith :  if  they  died  under 
their  torments  they  were  called  martyrs. 
TertuUian  speaks  of  confessors  as  martyrs 
elect,  and  St.  Cyprian  wrote  an  epistle  to 
the  "Martyrs  and  confessors  of  Jesus 
Christ."— Die*.  Christ.  Antiq.  p.  424. 

II.  A  name  given  to  a  priest  who  receives 
confession.     (See  Auricular  Confession.) 

CONFIRMATION.  This  is  a  Latin 
word  which  signifies  strengthening.  It  is 
used  to  express  the  rite  in  which  the 
in-dwelling  grace  of  the  Holy  Ghost  is 
sought  for  those  who  have  been  made 
children  of  God  in  baptism ;  to  which 
sacrament  it  is,  strictly  speaking,  a  supple- 
mental rite.  This  ordinance  is  called  con- 
flrmation,  because  they  who  duly  receive  it 
are  confirmed  or  strengthened  for  the  ful- 
filment of  their  Christian  duties  by  the 
grace  therein  bestowed  upon  them.  The 
words  which  accompany  confirmation  in  the 
Eastern  Churches  are,  "The  seal  of  the 
gift  of  the  Holy  Ghost : "  and  the  effect  of 
it  is  well  expressed  in  that  ancient  prayer 
which,  from  the  earliest  times,  has  been 
used  in  all  the  Western  Churches :  "  Al- 
mighty and  everlasting  God,  who  hast 
vouchsafed  to  regenerate  these  thy  servants, 
by  water  and  the  Holy  Ghost,  and  hast 
given  unto  them  forgiveness  of  all  their 
sins, — pour  into  them  thy  sevenfold  Spirit, 
the  Holy  Comforter  from  heaven ; "  or, 
"  Strengthen  them,  we  beseech  thee,  with 
the  Holy  Ghost,  the  Comforter." 

In  the  ea)ly  Church  confirmation  was 
administered  with  the  chrism,  or  consecrated 
oil  (see  Chrism);  and  this  is  still  done  in 
the  Greek  and  Roman  Churches,  TertuUian, 
Cyprian,  Cyril  of  Jerusalem,  and  other 
Fathers  speak  of  the  anointing  as  well  as  of 
the  laying  on  of  hands  in  confirmation 
(TertuU.  de  Bapt.  xii. ;  Cyp.  Ep.  Ixx.  3, 
Ixxiii.  8 ;  Cyril,  Catech.  Lect.  xix.,  xx.) ;  and 
offices  for  the  rite  are  found  in  the  Saora- 
mentaries  of  Gelasius  and  of  Gregory.  In 
the  Church  of  England,  only  the  laying  on 
of  hands  by  the  bishop  is  retained,  the  use 
of  the  chrism  having  been  entirely  abrogated, 

Q  2 


228 


CONFIEMATION 


in  consequence  of  the  superstition  attaching 
to  it.  Indeed  this  laying  on  of  the  bishop's 
hands  is  the  only  rite  mentioned  in  con- 
nection with  it  in  the  Scriptures :  "  Then 
laid  they  their  hands  upon  them,  and  they 
received  the  Holy  Ghost."     (Acts  viii.  17.) 

In  the  Epistle  to  the  Hebrews,  confirma- 
tion (there  spoken  of  under  the  term 
"laying  on  of  hands")  is  ranked  among 
the  chief  fundamentals  of  Christian  doctrine 
(Heb.  vi.  2),  and  must  therefore  be  of  per- 
petual obligation.  In  the  first  ages  of  the 
Church,  confirmation  appears  to  have  been 
administered  in  all  cases  as  soon  after 
liaptism  as  possible,  as  it  continues  to  be  in 
the  Greek  and  African  Churches.  But  in 
the  Western  Chm-ches,  for  the  last  three  or 
four  hundred  years,  the  bishops  have 
interposed  a  delay  of  seven  years  after 
infant  baptism  :  which  delay  in  the  English 
Churches  has  latterly  been  extended  to  from 
thirteen  to  sixteen  years — the  determination 
of  the  age  being  left  to  the  bishop.  At  the 
last  revision  of  our  Prayer  Book,  in  1661, 
confirmation  was  made  an  occasion  of 
requiring  from  those  who  have  been  baptized 
in  infancy,  a  renewal,  in  their  own  persons, 
of  the  engagements  of  the  baptismal  cove- 
nant. The  dispositions  of  mind  required  of 
those  who  would  benefit  by  confii'mation 
are  the  same  which  are  necessary  to  fit  men 
for  receiving  grace  in  the  sacraments; 
namely,  repentance  and  faith :  without 
which,  where  persons  are  capable  of  them, 
neither  this  nor  any  of  the  means  of  grace 
can  benefit  those  to  whom  they  are  adminis- 
tered. 

The  rubric  states  that  no  persons  are 
admissible  to  the  holy  communion  unless 
they  have  been  confirmed,  or  are  ready  and 
desirous  to  be  confirmed. 

The  60th  canon  orders  that  confirmation 
should  be  performed  by  the  bishops  once  in 
three  years,  but  there  are  few  dioceses  in 
England  in  which  the  bishop  does  not  now 
find  it  necessary  to  hold  confirmations  more 
frequently.  The  61st  canon  bids  every 
minister  to  "use  his  best  endeavour  to 
prepare  and  make  able,  and  likewise  to  pro- 
cure as  many  as  he  can  to  be  then  brought, 
and  by  the  bishop  to  be  confirmed."     [H.] 

CONFIRMATION  OP  A  BISHOP. 
To  understand  what  is  meant  by  the  con- 
firmation of  a  bishop,  it  may  be  proper  to 
state  the  process  adopted  in  England  before 
a  iDresbyter  can  be  consecrated  to  the  epis- 
copal office.  The  king  having  issued  his  conge 
d'elire  to  the  dean  and  chapter,  and  having 
nominated,  in  his  "  letters  missive,"  the 
person  whom  he  thinks  fit  to  be  chosen,  the 
dean  and  chapter  are  obliged,  within  twenty 
days  next  after  the  receipt  of  this  licence,  to 
make  the  election,  which  being  accepted  by 
the  party  elected,  is    certified  both  to  the 


CONG^  D'ELIEE 

sovereign  and  to  the  archbishop  of  the  pro- 
vince. If  the  dean  and  chapter  fail  to 
certify  the  election  within  twenty  days 
after  the  delivery  of  the  "  letters  missive," 
they  incur  the  penalty  of  prajmunire ;  and 
if  they  refuse  to  elect,  the  king  may 
nominate  by  letters  patent.  The  election 
being  certified,  the  kiiig  grants  his  royal 
assent  under  the  great  seal,  directed  to  the 
archbishop,  commanding  him  to  confirm  and 
consecrate  the  bishop  thus  elected ;  and  the 
archbishop  subscribes  it  "fiat  confirmatio," 
and  grants  a  commission  to  his  vicar-general 
for  that  purpose.  The  vicar-general  issues 
a  citation  to  summon  opposers,  which, 
for  the  province  of  Canterbury,  is  affixed 
on  the  door  of  Bow  Church,  and  three 
proclamations  are  made  thereof ;  this  being 
certified  to  the  vicar-general,  at  the  time 
and  place  appointed,  the  proctor  for  the 
dean  and  chapter  exhibit  the  royal  assent, 
and  the  archbishop's  commission  directed 
to  the  vicar-general.  After  this,  a  long 
and  formal  process  is  gone  through,  and 
after  six  proclamations  for  opposers,  if 
none  appear,  they  are  pironounced  con- 
tumacious. It  is  then  decreed  to  proceed  to 
sentence.  The  bishoj)  elect  takes  the  oaths 
of  office,  the  sentence  is  subscribed  by  the 
vicar-general,  and  the  election  is  ratified 
and  decreed  to  be  good.  (See  Bishops,  Elec- 
tion of.) 

Not  only  bishops,  but  deans  of  many 
cathedrals,  were  confirmed  by  their  dio- 
cesans ;  as  at  St.  Paul's  in  London,  and  St. 
Patrick's  m  Dublin.  (See  Oughton,  Ordo 
Judicium  de  ecclesici  Cathedr.  cxxvii.,  and 
Mason's  Hihernia,  p.  219.) 

CONFORMITY,  DECLARATION  OF. 
A  declaration  is  required  of  all  persons  who 
are  to  be  licensed  or  instituted  to  an  ecclesi- 
astical charge  in  the  Church  of  England,  in 
the  foUowing  words  : — "  I,  A.  B.,  do  declare 
that  I  will  conform  to  the  liturgy  of  the 
Church  of  England,  as  it  is  now  by  law 
established."  This  declaration  is  to  be  made 
and  subscribed  before  the  bishop  or  his 
commissary,  and  the  making  and  subscrip- 
tion thereof  is  to  be  testified  under  the 
episcopal  seal  of  the  bishop,  and  imder  the 
hand  of  the  bishop  or  his  commissary.  (See 
also  Eeading  in.) 

CONGli  D'ISLIRE.  This  is  a  Norman- 
French  term,  and  signifies  leave  to  choose ; 
and  is  the  king's  writ  or  licence  to  the 
dean  and  chapter  of  the  diocese  to  choose 
a  bishop,  in  the  time  of  vacancy  of  the  see. 
Before  the  Norman  Conquest,  bishops  in 
England  were  commonly  appointed  by  the 
king  and  the  Witenagemot.  After  the 
conquest  the  chapters  elected,  but  the 
election  was  commonly  made  in  the  King's 
chapel,  and  was  subject  to  his  approval,  so 
that  it  was  not  practically  free.     Prior  to 


CONGREGATION 

the  reign  of  Henry  I.,  the  kings  of  England 
used  to  invest  bishops  with  the  ring  and 
staff'.  Henry  I.,  as  the  result  of  his  contest 
■with  Anselm,  so  far  ceded  this  right  as  to 
give  a  conge  d'ilire  to  deans  and  chapters 
for  the  election  of  bishops.  Henry  VIII. 
added  "  letters  missive,"  nominating  the 
person  whom  he  required  them  to  elect, 
under  pain  of  pra;mmiire  ;  and  Edward  VI. 
(lEdw.  VI.  c.  1,  2)  abolished  elections  by 
■writ  of  conge  cCelire,  as  being  "  indeed  no 
elections,"  and  "  seeming  also  derogatory 
and  prejudicial  to  the  king's  prerogative 
royal,  to  whom  only  appertaineth  the  col- 
lation and  gift  of  all  archbishoprics,  and 
bishoprics,  and  suff'ragan  bishops,  within  his 
Highness's  said  realm."  The  statute  goes 
on  to  enact,  "  That  no  election  of  any  arch- 
bishop or  bishop  shall  be  made  by  the  dean 
and  chapter ;  "  but  that  the  king  by  his 
"  letters  patent,  at  all  times  when  the  arch- 
bishopric or  bishopric  be  void,  shall  confer 
the  same  to  any  person  whom  the  king  shall 
tbink  meet."  This  statute  was  repealed  by 
Queen  Mary,  and  never  afterwards  revived. 
The  law  now  rests  upon  the  25  Henry  VIII. 
c.  20,  which  statute  was  revived  by  Queen 
Elizabeth.  (See  Jurisdiction.')  But  in 
Ireland,  the  Act  of  2  Eliz.  c.  4,  established 
the  same  manner  of  appointment  by  the 
sovereign,  without  election,  as  the  English 
Act  of  Edward,  and  so  it  continued  till  the 
disestabUshment  of  the  Irish  Church.  [G.] 
CONGREGATION.  In  its  largest  sense, 
this  word  includes  the  whole  body  of  Chris- 
tian people,  considered  as  assembled,  not 
locally,  but  in  some  act  of  fellowship,  as 
when  it  is  said,  "  Let  the  congregation  of 
saints  praise  Him :  "  but  the  word  is  more 
commonly  used  for  the  worshippers,  being 
members  of  the  true  Church  assembled  in 
a  particular  place;  a  sense  in  which  the 
word  is  plainly  'used  in  the  prayer  for  the 
Church  militant,  where  an  especial  distinc- 
tion is  made  between  all  God's  people,  or 
the  congregation  of  the  saints,  and  the  parti- 
cular congregation  present  when  the  prayer 
is  used :  "  To  all  Thy  people  give  Thy 
heavenly  grace,  and  especially  to  this  con- 
gregation here  present."  The  ■word  con- 
f/regation  follows  therefore  the  use  of  the 
word  Ghurch ;  we  use  "  Tlie  Church"  for  the 
whole  body  of  Christ's  people,  and  "a 
Church,"  or  "  this  Church,"  for  a  particular 
portion  of  them.  And  as  a  Church  is  the 
immediate  bond  of  union  to  each  individual 
with  the  Church,  so  is  a  congregatioQ  the 
immediate  company  with  which  the  indi- 
vidual joins,  and  the  immediate  sign  of  his 
adherence  to  the  congregation  of  saints. 
Thus,  in  the  Order  of  Confirmation,  the 
preface  declares  that  lefore  the  Church 
children  should  ratify  their  baptismal  vow, 
and   they  are  consequently  asked  by  the 


CONGRESS 


220 


bishop  whether  they  do  this  "  in  the  pre- 
sence of  God  and  of  this  congregation." 
Congregation  and  Church  are  considered 
by  our  translators  convertible  terms :  e.g. 
Psal.  xxii.  22,  "  In  the  midst  of  the  con- 
gregation "  is  rendered  in  Heb.  ii.  12,  "  In 
the  midst  of  the  Church."  In  the  early 
translations  of  the  Bible  the  word  iKKXrja-ia 
was  rendered  "  congregation  "  in  St.  Matt, 
xvi.  8;  Acts  ii.  47 :  vii.  3 :  xii.  1 ;  Bph.  i. 
22,  23.  In  the  Bishop's  Bible  (1568)  the 
words  of  our  Lord  to  St.  Peter  are  given 
"  on  this  rock  I  will  build  my  congregation." 
In  the  Latin  version  of  Articles  xix.,  xxiii., 
xxiv.,  congregation  is  rendered  by  "  ecclesia." 
Compare  also  the  beginning  of  the  Bidding 
Prayer:  "Let  us  pray  for  Christ's  Holy 
Catholic  Church;  that  is,  for  the  whole 
congregation  of  Christian  people  dispersed 
throughout  the  world." 

CONGREGATION  IN  THE  PAPAL 
COURT,  means  a  committee  of  cardinals 
met  for  the  despatch  of  some  particular 
business,  and  each  congregation  is  denomi- 
nated from  the  peculiar  business  it  has  to 
despatch. 

Such  are  the  "  Pope's  congregation  "  insti- 
tuted by  Sixtus  V.  for  arranging  business : 
the  congregation  of  the  Holy  Office  (see  In- 
quisition) :  the  congregation  "  de  Propaganda 
fide  "  instituted  by  Gregory  XV. :  the  con- 
gregation for  explaining  the  Council  of  Trent 
(see  Trent,  Council  of) :  the  congregation  of 
the  Index  (see  Indexes') :  the  congregation 
of  Bishops  and  Regulars ;  for  the  examination 
of  bishops;  of  the  morals  of  bishops;  for 
the  Residence  of  bishops  ;  for  monasteries ; 
of  apostolical  visitation ;  of  relics ;  of  in- 
dulgences ;  of  rites ;  for  the  building  of 
churches.  (See  Relics,  Indulgences,  Brough- 
ton's  BihKo.  vol.  i.) 

CONGREGATION  Is  also  applied  in 
England  to  one  of  the  assemblies  of  the 
university  of  Oxford,  consisting  of  Regents, 
who  transact  the  ordinary  business  of  the 
universitj'. 

CONGREGATIONALISTS  are  nearly 
the  same  as  Independents.  (See  Inde- 
pendents.) The  principle  which  this  sect 
profes.ses  is  sho^wn  by  their  name ;  that  each 
congregation  should  be  quite  independent  of 
every  other  in  the  management  of  its  affairs 
and  teaching. 

CONGRESS,  CHURCH.  I.  There  has  of 
late  years  been  a  strong  and  growing  desire 
among  Churchmen  to  obtain  a  more  hearty 
co-operation  between  clergy  and  laity.  In 
the  earher  times  of  the  Church  the  leading 
laymen  were  consulted  by  the  bishops,  and 
others  held  offices,  and  assisted  in  the  work 
of  the  Church,  without  being  admitted  to 
holy  orders.  (See  Lay  Helpers.)  This  lay 
help  became  absorbed  by  the  monks  and 
friars,  and  when  in   England  monasteries 


230 


CONGEESS 


were  swept  away,  and  these  religious  com- 
munities alMlished,  there  was  nothing  to 
take  their  place.  After  the  Eeforraation 
laymen  were  little  consulted,  and  indeed 
there  seems  for  a  long  time  to  have  been 
little  concerted  action  on  the  part  of  the 
rulers  of  the  Church,  which  perhaps  was 
one  of  the  causes  which  led  to  the  apathy 
and  want  of  energy  which  characterized  the 
end  of  the  last  century  and  the  beginning 
of  this.  When  convocation  was  revived 
(see  Convocation)  a  proposal  was  made  that 
a  certain  number  of  laymen  should  be 
elected  as  proctors ;  and  this  has  been  re- 
newed since.  But  there  were  many  ob- 
jections to  such  an  innovation  on  the  old 
idea  of  convocation.  It  therefore  was  de- 
termined by  some  earnest  Churchmen  to 
organise  annual  meetings,  or  congresses,  to 
promote  Church  extension  and  Church  de- 
fence, at  which  the  prominent  and  important 
practical  subjects  of  the  day  should  be 
discussed  by  leading  men  both  of  the  clergy 
and  laity,  the  discussion  of  points  of  theo- 
logical doctrine  and  speculation  being  ex- 
cluded. The  congress  was  to  be  open  to 
aU,  but  eminent  men  were  to  be  invited  to 
prepare  papers,  and  to  deliver  speeches,  and 
none  but  members  of  the  Church  of  Eng- 
land or  of  Churches  in  communion  with  her 
allowed  to  speak.  The  first  Church  con- 
gress was  held  at  Cambridge  in  1861,  under 
the  presidency  of  Archdeacon  France,  and 
from  that  time  to  the  present  such  meetings 
have  been  held  annually.  At  Oxford  in 
the  next  year  the  bishop  of  the  diocese,  Dr. 
Wilberforce,  who  took  a  great  and  active 
interest  in  the  working  of  these  congresses, 
presided ;  and  since  then  the  bishop  of  the 
diocese  in  which  the  place  of  meeting  is 
situated  has  acted  as  president.  At  "York 
In  1866,  and  at  Sheffield  in  1878,  the  Arch- 
bishop of  York  presided ;  as  did  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury  at  Croydon  in  1877. 
The  congresses  have  been  largely  attended, 
and  representative  men,  both  of  theclergy  and 
laity,  have  taken  part  in  the  proceedings. 

II.  The  Church  congresses  were  followed 
by  the  revival  of  ruri-decanal  action  and  also 
by  Diocesan  Confekences.  These  are  meet- 
ings of  the  clergy  and  laity  in  individual 
dioceses,  certain  clerical  and  lay  members 
being  elected,  generally  at  ruri-decanal 
meetings,  tc  represent  the  others  at  the 
general  diocesan  conference.  The  times 
of  meeting  vary  in  different  dioceses,  at  the 
wiU  of  the  bishop,  but  in  most  cases  the 
conferences  are  annual.  Conferences  of  this 
kind  are  held  in  all  the  dioceses  except 
"Worcester.  The  result  of  these  diocesan 
conferences  was  even  better  than  was  ex- 
pected ;  great  interest  has  been  taken  in  them, 
and  they  have  been  the  means  of  bringing 
leading  laymen,  and  clergy  in  the  different 


CONSANGUINITY 

dioceses,  together,  to  discuss  the  burning 
questions  of  the  day,  and  they  have  become 
handmaids  to  convocation.  But  even  this 
was  not  altogether  satisfactory,  and  a  more 
united  action  seemed  to  be  required.  There- 
fore in  1879  and  1880  some  of  the  secre- 
taries and  leading  men  of  the  conferences 
met  together  in  London,  to  consider  whether 
any  and  what  steps  should  be  taken  to 
further  such  more  united  action  in  both 
provinces,  and  to  bring  the  combined  voice 
and  wishes  of  Churchmen,  lay  as  well  as 
clerical,  to  bear  upon  the  two  convoca- 
tions, the  Parliament  and  the  country,  for 
the  promotion  of  measures  acknowledged 
as  desirable.  The  result  of  their  delibera- 
tions has  been  the  formation  of — 

III.  The  Central  Council  of  Diocesan  Con- 
ferences. This  Council  is  now  constituted  of 
representatives  elected  by  the  diocesan  con- 
ferences, in  the  proportion  of  six  to  each 
diocese,  three  clerical  and  three  lay.  Others, 
though  not  representatives,  may  by  special 
invitation  be  present  and  speak  but  not 
vote.  The  president  is  elected  annually. 
The  business  of  the  council  is  directed  by 
an  executive  committee  composed  of  15  lay 
and  15  clerical  members,  elected  yearly. 
The  main  objects  are  (1)  to  gather' up  the 
past  decisions  of  diocesan  conferences,  and 
to  discuss  them  through  their  representa- 
tives ;  (2)  to  suggest  subjects  for  considera- 
tion in  future  diocesan  conferences ;  (3)  to 
obtain  the  general  opinion  of  the  Church 
on  matters  affecting  its  welfare,  with  a 
view  to  their  being  brought  prominently,  if 
thought  desirable,  before  the  convocations 
and  Parliament.  The  system  has  been 
worked  out  carefully,  and  seems  to  be 
complete.  The  ruri-decanal  chapters  or 
meetings  appoint  representatives,  lay  and 
clerical,  for  the  diocesan  conference ;  the 
diocesan  conference  appoints  representatives 
for  the  central  council;  the  central  coun- 
cil lays  the  collected  decisions  before  the 
bishops  and  convocation  :  while  at  the  same 
time  annual  congresses  of  the  whole  Church 
of  England  are  held,  at  which  any  one  may 
express  his  individual  opinion.  (See  Offi- 
cial Year  Book,  1883,  p.  380,  405 ;  1885, 
p.  336.)     [H.] 

CONGRUITY.  (See  Condignity.) 
CONSANGUINITY.  Connexion  by 
blood,  as  affinity  is  alliance  by  marriage. 
The  degrees  of  consanguinity  and  affinity 
■within  which  marriages  are  null  and  void 
by  the  Act  of  1835,  and  were  previously 
voidable  by  the  ecclesiastical  courts,  are 
those  contained  in  the  Table  of  Prohibited 
Degrees  compiled  by  Abp.  Parker  in  the 
time  of  Queen  Elizabeth  and  printed  in  all 
Prayer  Books,  though  it  is  legally  no  part 
thereof,  and  derives  its  real  authority  from 
the   Act  of  25  Hen.  VIII.  c.  22,  and  the 


CONSCIENCE  CLAUSES 

previous  law  of  the  Ghurcli.     This  Table  is 
to    be    found  in  all   Prayer  Books.     (See 

CONSCIENCE  CLAUSES.  (See  Schools.) 

CONSECEATION.  The  solemn  act  ol' 
■dedicating  any  thing  or  xierson  to  a  Divine 
service  and  use. 

CONSECRATION  OP  A  BISHOP.  By 
this  we  mean  the  separating  of  a  person  for 
the  holy  office  of  a  bishop,  by  imposition  of 
hands  and  prayer. 

I.  The  laying  on  of  hands,  accompanied 
■with  prayer,  and  earnest  preparation,  was 
all  that  was  required  in  the  time  of  the 
Apostles,   and    is  of    Scriptural   authority 
(Acts  vi.  6 ;  1  Tim.  iv.  14 ;  v.  22 ;  2  Tim.  i. 
6).     But  in  this  case,  as  in  many  others,  in 
the  early  age  of  Christianity,   other  rites 
were    adopted,    and    these    again,    in    the 
mediajval  age,    received  further   additions. 
The  earliest  addition  made  to  the  "  imposi- 
tion of  hands,"  was  the  laying  of  the  gospels 
upon  the  head,   or  neck,  or  shoulders,  of 
the  person  to  be  consecrated  to   the  holy 
office.     Of   this  mention  is  made  in   the 
Apostolic  Constitutions  (viii.  4),  where  two 
deacons  are  appointed  to  hold  the  gospels 
over  his  head ;  and  in  one  of  the  councils 
ofi,Carthage  (iv.  c.   2),  at  which   it  was 
ordered  that  two  bishops  were  so  to  hold 
the   book  of  the  gospels  while   the   chief 
bishop,  or  primate,  with  two  other  bishops 
assisting  him,   pronounced    the  prayer   of 
consecration.      St.  Chrysostom  also  refers 
to  this  custom.     (Bingham,  bk.  ii.  c.  11.) 
Another    rite  was    the    anointing   of    the 
head  at  the  consecration,  but  reference  to 
this  is  not  found  in  very  early  writers.     In 
the    sixth    century   it   was    probably  the 
■custom  in  Italy  (St.  Leo,  M.  Serm.  viii.  de 
Passion    Domini),    but  rarely  elsewhere, 
though  mention  is  made  of  it  as  existing  in 
England   in  the  eighth  century  (Egbert's 
Fontif.  ed.  Greenwell).     The  delivery  of  a 
pastoral  staff  and  a  ring  was  also  part  of  the 
Western  rite  of  consecration,  and  this   is 
mentioned  in  the  Pontificals  of  Gregory  the 
Great,  and  of  Egbert,  but  not  in  the  earlier 
ones  of  Leo  or  Gelasius.     It  also  is  referred 
to  in  the  fourth  council  of  Toledo,  a.d.  633. 
The  delivery  of  the  paten  and  chalice  is 
mentioned  in  the  Sacramentary  of  Gregory, 
but  the  delivery  of  the  mitre  was  later. 
{Seeilfiire,-  Maskell's ilfom.  Eit.Ang.Ecd.u. 
290,  note.)     Connected  also  with  the  con- 
secration of  bishops  was  the  enthronization, 
and  delivery  of  the  pallium.    (See  Enthroni- 
zation, Pallium ;  Maskell,  ii.,  cxliii.  and  ii., 
cclv.  seq. ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  222.) 

n.  The  ordainers  or  consecrators  were 
necessarily  bishops,  and  two  or  more  were 
required  to  take  part  "  'ErrlcrKOTros  ^eipoTov- 
ticrda  VTTO  iiricTKonav  5vo>  fj  rpiZv,"  is  the 
first    so   called    Apostolic    canon;    and    a 


CONSECRATION 


231 


similar  order  is  given  in  the  Constitutions 
(Apost.  Const,  viii.  4).     Many  councils  re- 
quire a  larger  number  to  participate;  for 
instance,  according  to  a  canon  of  the  first 
Nicene  Council  (Can.  IV.)  there  must  he 
four,  or  at  least  three,  bishops  present  at 
the  consecration  of  a  bishop.     This  rule  has 
generally  been  followed.     In   the  form  of 
ordaining  or  consecrating  a  bishop  in  the 
English    Church,   the    rubrics    imply  the 
presence  of  at  least  three.     The  archbishop, 
or  some  other  bishop  appointed  by  lawful 
commission,  performs  the  office:  "another 
bishop    shall    read    the    Epistle,"    "  then 
another    bishop    shall  read    the    Gospel." 
The  bishop  elect  is  also  presented  by  two 
bishops  to  the  archbishop.     In  the  preface 
to  this  form  it  is  stated  that "  no  one  shall 
be  accounted  or  taken  to    be   a    bishop, 
or  suffered  to  execute  the   same  function, 
unless  he  be   called,   tried,   and  admitted 
thereunto  according  to  that  form,  or   hath 
had  formerly  episcopal  consecration."     The 
concluding  portion  of  tliis  sentence  recognises 
the  validity  of  consecrations  given  in  foreign 
Churches  by  any  other   form  adopted   by 
those  Churches.      Thus  a  French,   or  an 
Italian,  or  a  Greek  bishop,  conforming  to 
the  rules  of  the  Church  of  England,  would 
seem  to  require  no  fresh  consecration,  but  is 
at  liberty  to  officiate  among  us. 

But  that  alone  does  not  give  them  or 
their  ordinees  any  right  to  officiate  here ; 
much  less  to  hold  benefices  or  curacies. 
Even  those  who  were  ordained  in  our  own 
colonies  could  not  until  recent  legislation, 
as  explained  under  the  Church  in  Scotland 
and  in  the  Colonies.  The  present  position  of 
all  bishops  and  clergy  not  consecrated  or 
ordained  by  bishops  of  an  English  diocese  is 
determined  by  the  Colonial  Clergy  Act,  1874. 
Some  persons  appear  to  have  apprehended 
that  that  Act  per  incuriam  put  ordinary 
English  suffi-agans  in  the  same  position 
as  Colonial,  Scotch,  American,  or  Roman 
clergy.  But  the  apprehension  is  unfounded, 
and  contrary  to  the  rules  of  legal  construc- 
tion. No  such  repeal  of  old  rights  is  ex- 
pressly made  by  the  Act ;  and  a  suffi-agan 
bishop  would  certainly  be  held  to  be  "a 
bishop  of  the  English  diocese  "  in  which  he  is 
commissioned  under  the  Suffragan  Act  of 
26  Hen.  VIII.,  so  long  as  he  was  acting 
under  and  within  his  commission. 

After  the  Reformation  an  attempt  was 
made  to  prove  that  the  line  of  English 
bishops  (see  Apostolic  Succession)  had  been 
broken  by  a  defect  in  the  consecration  of 
Archbishop  Parker  (see  Nag's  Head  Fiction) ; 
but  this  has  been  refuted,  and  by  no  one 
more  decisively  rejected  than  by  Dr.  Lingard, 
himself  a  Roman  Catholic. — Hist,  of  Enrj. 
vol.  vi..  Appendix,  Note  DD. 

By  the  eighth  canon  it  is  ordered, "  Who- 


232 


CONSECEATION 


ever  shall  affirm  or  teach,  tliat  the  fonii  and 
manner  of  making  and  consecrating  bishops, 
priests,  and  deacons,  containeth  anything  in 
it  that  is  repugnant  to  the  word  of  God; 
or  that  they  who  are  made  bishops,  priests, 
or  deacons  in  that  form  are  not  lawfully 
made,  nor  ought  to  be  accounted,  either  by 
themselves  or  others,  to  be  truly  either 
bishops,  priests,  or  deacons,  until  they 
have  some  other  calling  to  those  Divine 
offices ;  let  him  be  excommunicated  ipso 
facto,  not  to  be  restored  until  he  repent,  and 
publicly  revoke  such  his  wicked  errors." 

The  36th  Article,  and  the  Act  of  Uni- 
formity (13  &  14  Car.  II.),  also  assert  the 
validity  of  the  said  form.     [H.] 

CONSECRATION  OF  CHURCHES. 
The  law  recognises  no  place  as  a  church 
until  it  has  been  consecrated  by  the  bishop. 

In  the  Church  of  England  the  bishop  is 
left  to  his  own  discretion  as  to  the  form  he 
will  use  in  the  consecration  of  a  church  ; 
but  in  the  21  Henry  VIII.  c.  13,  which 
limits  the  number  of  chaplains  that  each 
person  may  have,  one  reason  assigned  why 
a  bishop  may  retain  six  chaplains  is  because 
he  must  occupy  that  number  in  the  con- 
secration of  churches. 

The  custom  of  solemnly  setting  apart, 
from  ordinary  and  secular  use,  whatever 
is  appropriated  to  the  sei"vice  of  Almighty 
God,  has  the  highest  possible  sanction ;  for 
many  are  the  instances  of  it  recorded  in  the 
Holy  Scriptures.  True  it  is  that  there  is 
no  record  of  any  such  ceremonial  having 
been  used  among  Christians  in  reference  to 
churches,  before  the  fourth  century,  though 
some  ritualists  are  of  opinion  that  a  form  of 
dedication  was  common  much  earlier.  No 
sooner,  however,  was  the  sword  of  persecu- 
tion sheathed,  and  God  permitted  His  Church 
to  serve  Him  in  all  godly  quietness,  than 
such  solemnities  became  general.  Then, 
as  Eusebius  tells  us,  (S".  E.  x.  2,)  "  there 
was  an  incessant  joy,  and  there  sprung  up 
for  all  a  certain  celestial  gladness,  seeing 
every  place,  which  but  a  short  time  before 
had  been  desolated  by  the  impieties  of  the 
tyrants,  reviving  again,  and  recovering 
from  a  long  and  deadly  distemper ;  temples 
again  rising  from  the  soil  to  a  lofty  height, 
and  receiving  a  splendour  far  exceeding 
those  which  had  been  formerly  destroyed." 
And  again :  "  after  this  the  sight  was 
afforded  us,  so  eagerly  desired  and  prayed 
for  by  all, — the  festival  of  dedications,  and 
consecrations  of  the  newly-erected  houses  of 
prayer  throughout  the  cities.  After  this, 
the  convention  of  bishops,  the  concourse  of 
foreigners  from  abroad,  the  benevolence  of 
people  to  people,  the  unity  of  the  members 
of  Christ  concurring  in  one  harmonious 
body.  Then  was  it  according  to  the  prophe- 
tic declaration,  mystically  indicating  what 


CONSECEATION 

would  take  place, '  bone  was  brought  to  bone, 
and  joint  to  joint,'  and  whatsoever  other 
matters  the  Divine  word  faithfully  intimated 
before.  There  was,  also,  one  energy  of  the 
Divine  Spirit  pervading  all  the  members, 
and  one  soul  among  all,  one  and  the  same 
ardour  of  faith,  one  song  of  praise  to  the 
Deity;  yea  now,  indeed,  complete  and 
perfect  solemnities  of  the  prelates  and  heads 
of  the  Church,  sacred  performances  of 
sacred  rites,  and  solemn  rituals  of  the 
Church.  Here  you  might  hear  the  singing 
of  psalms;  there,  the  performance  of 
divine  and  sacred  mysteries.  The  mystic 
symbols  of  our  Saviour's  passion  were  cele- 
brated ;  and,  at  the  same  time,  each  sex  of 
every  age,  male  and  female,  with  the  power 
of  the  mind,  and  with  a  mind  and  whole 
heart  rejoicing  in  prayer  and  thanksgiving, 
gave  glory  to  God,  the  author  of  all  good. 
Every  one  of  the  prelates  present  also  de- 
livered panegyrical  discourses,  desirous  of 
adding  lustre  to  the  assembly,  according  to 
the  ability  of  each."  One  such  discourse, 
pronounced  by  Eusebius  himself,  still  re- 
mains. 

In  his  life  of  Constantino,  Eusebius  gives 
an  instance  of  the  ceremonial  thus  described 
in  the  consecration,  amid  a  full  synod  of 
bishops,  of  the  Chm'ch  of  Jerusalem,  which 
Constantine  bad  built  over  our  Saviour's 
sepulchre,  a.d.  335.  Socrates  records  a 
similar  consecration  of  the  famous  Church  of 
Antioch,  called  Dominicum  Aureum,  which 
was  begun  by  Constantine  and  finished  by 
Constantius,  a.d.  341.  Testimony  to  the 
prevalency  of  this  custom  is  also  borne  by 
St.  Athanasius,  who  defends  himself  in  his^ 
apology  to  Constantius  (c.  14-18),  when 
charged  with  having  used  a  building  for 
public  worship,  before  it  was  dedicated  by 
the  emperor,  and  consecrated  by  himself,  oa 
the  ground  of  necessity ;  for  since  during 
Lent  the  congregations  in  the  ordinary 
churches  had  been  so  crowded  as  to  prove 
injurious  to  the  persons  present,  and  anti- 
cipating still  more  crowded  assemblies  at 
Easter,  he  thought  himself  justified,  under 
such  circumstances,  to  use  an  edifice  which 
was  unconsecrated.  St.  Gregory  Nazianzen 
likewise  speaks  of  this  ceremonial  as  an 
ancient  custom  (TraXato?  vo^os). 

Such  then  were  the  offices  connected  with 
the  consecration  of  churches  in  primitive, 
times.  Bishops,  from  distant  provinces, 
with  a  vast  concourse  of  clergy  and  laity,, 
were  present;  an  appropriate  sermon  or 
sermons  were  preached ;  the  holy  Eucharist 
was  always  administered  ;  in  the  co\irse  of 
which  prayers  suitable  to  the  occasion  were 
offered.  Of  these  prayers  one  is  still  pre- 
served in  the  writings  of  St.  Ambrose. 

On  this  model  it  was  that  the  consecra- 
tion services  of  the  Church  Catholic  were. 


CONSECRATION 

fonned,  each  church,  at  first,  vavyin<;  in 
non-essentials,  as  ciicumstauces  may  liave 
required. 

In  the  English  Church,  various  records  of 
very  early  date  exist  relating  to  the  conse- 
cration of  churches.  Geoffrey  of  Monmouth, 
■who  professes  to  follow  Gildas,  says  that  in 
the  time  of  King  Lucius  (a.d.  162)  pagan 
temples  v/ere  consecrated  in  Britain  to  the 
honour  of  the  true  God.  And  we  find  from 
Beds,  H.  E.  i.  25,  26,  that  t)ie  passage  just 
quoted  from  Eusebius  was  applicable  to  our 
own  island.  It  is  known  that  Bertha,  wife 
of  Ethelbert,  king  of  Kent,  repaired  or  re- 
built a  church,  first  built  by  the  Romans, 
and  had  it  dedicated  to  the  honour  of  St. 
Martin  of  Tours,  an  eminent  saint  among 
the  Christians  of  her  native  country.  This 
was  the  church  granted  by  Ethelbert  to 
Augustine,  on  his  landing  in  the  isle  of 
Thanet,  a.d.  596.  Some  time  after  his 
arrival,  Gregory  the  Great  sent  Augustine 
particular  instructions  about  the  dedication 
of  the  temples  of  the  Anglo-Saxons ;  and 
when  the  bishop  had  his  episcopal  see  as- 
signed him  in  the  royal  city,  he  recovered 
therein  a  church,  which  he  was  informed 
had  been  built  by  the  ancient  Koman 
Christians,  and  consecrated  in  the  name  of 
our  holy  Saviour,  God  and  Lord,  Jesus 
Christ.  From  the  same  historian  we  learn, 
that  Laurentius,  Augustine's  successor  in 
the  primacy,  consecrated  a  church  to  St. 
Peter  and  St.  Paul,  afterwards  called  St. 
Augustine's,  in  honour  of  Augustine,  who 
had  commenced  building  it.  Mellitus, 
who  succeeded  Laurentius,  consecrated  the 
church  of  the  Holy  Mother  of  God,  built  by 
King  Eadbald,  a.d.  622.  There  is  a  de- 
tailed account  of  the  consecration  of  the 
church  of  Eipon,  by  Wilfrid,  archbishop  of 
York,  A.D.  665,  given  in  the  life  of  that 
prelate,  written  by  Eddius  and  Fridegode. 
Numerous  subsequent  canons  are  found, 
bearing  on  the  same  subject.  For  instance, 
one  of  Archbishop  Ecgberht's  "  Excerptions," 
A.D.  740,  relates  to  the  consecration  of 
churches.  In  Archbishop  Wulfred's  canons, 
passed  at  the  Council  of  Chalchuith : 

"  When  a  church  is  built,  let  it  be  con- 
secrated by  the  bishop  of  its  own  diocese, 
according  to  the  ministerial  book." — ^Wilkins, 
Cone.  torn.  i.  169. 

Again,  in  the  canons  of  Archbishop 
William  of  Corbeuil,  a.d.  1126,  in  the 
canons  at  Westminster,  a.d.  1138,  and  in 
Archbishop  Richard's  canons,  a.d.  1175, 
similar  injunctions  are  given. 

From  the  Constitutions  of  Otho,  a.d. 
1237,  it  would  appear  that  this  solemnity 
was  then  much  neglected.  This  is  evident 
from  the  title  "  de  consecratione,  et  reforma- 
tione  status  ecclesiaj,"  and  from  the  first  of 
the  canons,  which,  after  observing  that  the 


COKSECRATION 


23S 


dedication  of  royal  temples  is  known  to  have 
taken  its  beginning  from  the  Old  Testament, 
and  was  observed  by  the  holy  fathers  in  the 
New  Testament,  under  which  it  ought  to  bo 
done  with  the  greater  care  aud  dignity,  &c., 
goes  on  to  enact, 

"  That  hecause  we  have  ourselves  seen,  and 
heard  hij  Tnany,  that  so  wholesome  a  mystery 
is  despised,  at  least  neglected,  hy  some  (for 
we  have  found  many  churches,  and  some 
cathedrals,  not  consecrated  with  holy  oil 
though  built  of  old),  we,  therefore,  being 
desirous  to  obviate  so  great  a  neglect,  do 
ordain  and  give  in  charge,  that  all  cathedrals, 
conventual  and  parochial  churches,  which 
are  ready  built,  and  their  walls  perfected,  be 
consecrated  by  the  diocesan  bishops,  to 
whom  they  belong,  or  others  authorised  by 
them,  within  two  years  :  and  let  it  so  be 
done  in  a  like  time  in  all  churches  hereafter 
to  be  built ;  and  lest  so  wholesome  a  statute 
grow  into  contempt,  if  such  like  places  be 
not  dedicated  within  two  years  from  the 
time  of  their  being  finished,  we  decree  them 
to  remain  interdicted  from  the  solemnization 
of  masses  until  they  be  consecrated,  unless 
they  be  excused  for  some  reasonable  cause." 

In  the  constitutions  of  Othobon,  a.d. 
1268,  there  is  a  similar  canon. 

The  reformers,  when  reforming  the  other 
services  of  the  Church,  did  not  extend  their 
labours  to  that  of  consecration.  Indeed,  as 
the  sixteenth  century  was  a  period,  to  use 
the  words  of  Bishop  Short,  when  more 
churches  were  destroyed  than  built,  there 
was  no  immediate  use  for  the  service  in 
question.  This  task  was  reserved  for  Bishop 
Andrewes,  whose  service  was  compiled,  aa 
were  all  the  offices  of  the  English  Church, 
from  the  formularies  in  use  before  the  Re- 
formation. 

Unanswerable  as  was  Hooker's  defence  of 
the  consecration  of  churches  {Eccl.  Pol.  v. 
12),  it  was  insufficient  to  protect  Laud  from 
the  clamour  of  his  implacable  enemies,  when 
he  consecrated  St.  Catherine  Cree  church,  as 
bishop  of  London,  in  1630.  And  in  the 
well-known  London  petition,  presented  to 
the  Long  Parliament,  by  the  notorious 
Alderman  Pennington,  abeut  ten  years  later, 
the  consecration  of  churches  was  not  for- 
gotten to  be  included  "  among  the  manifold 
evils,  pressures,  and  grievances,  caused, 
practised,  and  occasioned  by  the  prelates 
and  their  dependants." 

At  the  Restoration  the  custom  revived, 
and  the  subject  was  again  discussed ;  but  as 
there  was  no  authorised  ofiice  (Laud,  having 
been  prevented  from  drawing  up  a  form,  as 
he  intended,  in  the  convocation  of  16iO), 
the  preparation  of  one  was  committed  to 
Bishop  Cosin  in  the  convocation  of  1661. 
When  prepared  it  was  presented  to  the 
house,  and  referred  to  a  committee  of  four 


23i 


CONSECRATION 


bishops  for  revision,  but  notliing  seems 
ultimately  to  have  been  done  about  it. 
Since  that  period  each  bishop  has  adopted 
any  form  he  thought  best,  though  perhaps 
the  form  of  conseciuting  churches,  chapels, 
and  churchyards,  or  places  of  burial,  \vhich 
was  sent  down  by  the  bishops  to  the  lower 
houses  of  convocation  (1712),  and  altered 
by  a  committee  of  the  whole  bouse,  is  the 
one,  not  that  it  is  enjoined  by  any  competent 
authority,  now  most  generally  used. 

Different  rites  were  jo^epared  by  Barlow, 
bishop  of  Lincoln ;  Patrick,  bishop  of  Elj^ ; 
and  King,  bishop  of  London. — Palmer, 
Orig.  Lit.  ii.  371.  (/See  Harrington,  on  the 
Consecration  of  CJiurcJies ;  Maskell,  Moji. 
Bit.  Ecd.  Ang.  i.  326.) 

[The  Acts  of  Parliament  which  prescribe 
or  give  certain  legal  effects  to  consecration 
of  churches  and  churchyards  prescribe  no 
particular  form  of  it.  The  customary  re- 
ligious service  alone  would  have  no  legal 
effect,  nor  the  absence  of  it.  That  is  pro- 
duced by  the  bishop  signing  in  the  church 
the  usual  "  sentence  of  consecration  "  on  the 
petition  of  the  then  owners  of  the  land  and 
building,  which  he  also  orders  to  be  registered 
in  the  registry  of  the  diocese.  From  this  it 
followed,  as  lawyers  must  have  known,  be- 
fore the  decision  of  the  Privy  Council  in 
Parlcer  v.  Leach  (1  P.  C.  312),  reversing  a 
former  decision,  founded  on  Popish  law, 
that  reconsecration,  where  no  more  ground 
is  added,  has  no  legal  meaning,  necessity,  or 
effect,  though  it  had  often  been  done  when 
churches  were  entirely  rebuilt.  The  religious 
service  called  consecration  may  be  performed 
there,  if  the  bishop  pleases,  but  nothing  else 
should  be  done.  Moreover,  all  rites  and 
ceremonies  will  be  valid,  by  the  Declaratorv 
Act,  30  &  31  Vict.  c.  133,  if  any  part  oi 
the  church  remains  on  the  old  site.  But 
if  it  covers  any  new  ground,  that  will  not 
become  the  property  of  the  church  without 
either  conveyance  or  consecration  or  lapse 
of  time.  By  59  G.  III.  c.  134,  s.  40,  churches 
may  be  removed  to  entirely  new  sites  by 
faculty  and  consent  of  all  the  parties  in- 
terested. Such  churches,  of  course,  require 
consecration.  The  consecration  of  parochial 
churchyards  or  cemeteries  now  does  nothing, 
since  the  Burials  Act,  1880,  and  some 
bishops  accordingly  refuse  to  do  it.]     [C] 

COiSISECliATlUN  OF  THE  ELE- 
MENTS. A  prayer  of  consecration,  or 
setting  apart  the  bread  and  wine  to  the 
sacred  purpose  in  which  they  are  about  to 
be  employed,  hath  been  used  for  that  end 
at  least  1600  years.  And  the  mention 
which  our  office  makes  of  the  institution  of 
the  Lord's  supper,  from  the  words,  "  who  in 
the  same  night  that  he  was  betrayed,"  to 
the  conclusion,  is  in  every  old  liturgy  in 
the  world. 


CONSECRATION 

It  is  contained  in  the  well-known  account 
by  Justin  Martyr  {Apost.  i.  c.  65)  of  the 
celebration  of  Holy  Communion  in  his  time. 
Irenasus  speaks  of  the  consecration  of  the 
bread ;  "  it  has,"  he  says,  "  the  invocation 
of  God  upon  it,  and  then  it  is  no  longer 
common  bread,  but  the  Eucharist."  "  Qui 
est  a  terra  panis,  percipiens  invocationem 
Dei,  jam  non  communis  panis  est,  sed 
Eucharistia"  (lib.  iv.  cap.  34).  In  the 
Apostolic  Constitutions  the  words  of  conse- 
cration are  quoted  (viiL  c.  12).  St.  Cyril  of 
Jerusalem  gives  an  account  of  the  service 
as  it  was  actually  celebrated  at  his  own 
church  in  the  early  part  of  the  fourth  cen- 
tury. After  prayer  and  preparation  "we 
beseech,"  he  says, "  the  merciful  God  to  send 
forth  His  Holy  Spirit  upon  to.  Ti-poKeliieva," 
that  is,  the  elements  placed  on  the  altar, 
"  to  make  the  bread  the  Body  of  Christ, 
and  the  wine  the  Blood  of  Christ "  (Cyr. 
Catech.  Myst.  iii.  n.  3).  In  Tertullian's 
works,  in  those  of  Origen,  Basil,  Chrysostom, 
and  in  fact  in  most  of  the  early  writers,  we 
find  similar  allusions  made  to  the  consecra- 
tion of  the  elements.- — Bingham,  bk.  xv.  c.  3. 
II.  In  the  Eastern  Church  there  is  a  dis- 
tinct invocation  of  the  Holy  Spirit,  "  Sharer 
of  the  throne  and  of  the  kingdom  with  God 
and  Father  and  Thine  Only  Begotten  Son, 
consubstantial,  co-eternal,"  that  He  "may 
hallow  and  make  this  bread  the  holy  body 
of  Thy  Christ ;  and  this  cup  the  precious 
blood  of  Thy  Christ ; "  without  which  the 
consecration  of  the  elements  is  not  considered 
complete  (^Lit.  of  St.  James;  Neale  and 
Littledale's  trans.  Anc.  Lit.  p.  51).  But 
the  Western  Church  has  always  maintained 
that  the  consecration  is  completed  by  the 
recitation  of  our  Blessed  Lord's  words,  as 
bringing  Himself  in  to  be  the  Consecrator 
of  the  Holy  Sacrament.  In  most  of  the 
ancient  liturgies,  before  "He  blessed", the 
words  are  inserted,  "our  Lord  looked  up 
to  heaven,"  though  this  is  not  mentioned  in 
the  accounts  of  the  Institution  given  in  the 
gospels.  The  Sarum  and  Roman  liturgies 
direct  the  celebrant  to  raise  his  eyes  to 
heaven. 

"  It  is  peculiar  to  this  celebration,"  says 
Bishop  Cosin,  "  that  the  death  of  our  Lord 
is  commemorated  therein,  not  by  bare  words 
as  in  other  prayers,  but  by  certain  sacred 
symbols,  signs  and  sacrament,  which  are, 
according  to  St.  Augustine,  a  sort  of '  visible 
words.' "  According  to  the  Prayer  Book  of 
1549,  following  the  "Sarum  Use,"  the 
celebrant  was  to  make  the  sign  of  the  cross 
over  the  elements  several  times;  but  this 
was  discontinued  in  1552,  and  the  only 
direction  is  that  he  shall  take  the  paten  into 
his  hands,  break  the  bread,  lay  his  hand 
upon  all  the  bread,  take  the  chalice,  ami 
lay  his  hand  upon  every  vessel  in    which 


CONSECRATION 

there  is  any  wine  to  be  consecrated.  The 
prayer  of  consecration  was  also  changed,  the 
words  "and  with  Thy  Holy  Spirit,"  and 
"  vouchsafe  to  bless  and  sanctify  these  1'liy 
gifts  and  creatures  that  they  may  bo  to 
us  the  body  and  blood  of  Christ,"  being 
omitted.  In  the  American  and  Scotch 
Liturgies  they  are  re-inserted,  except  that 
the  Scotch  oflSce  omits  the  words  "  to  us." 
— Bingham,  book  xv.  o.  iii. ;  Annot.  P.  B. 
ii.  187  ;  See  Mixed  Chalice,  Eucliarist. 

"  We  do  not  eat  our  common  food  without 
first  praying  for  a  blessing  on  it;  which 
pious  custom  is  so  universal,  that  it  is 
certainly  a  piece  of  natural  religion;  how 
much  more  then  are  we  obliged,  before  we 
eat  and  drink  this  bread  and  wine,  which 
Christ  designed  to  set  forth  the  mystery  of 
His  death,  to  consecrate  it  and  set  it  apart 
by  a  solemn  prayer ;  especially  since  Christ 
Himself  in  the  institution  of  this  sacred 
ordinance,  while  He  was  teaching  His 
Apostles  how  to  celebrate  it,  did  use  a  form 
of  blessing  over  it  (St.  Matt.  xxvi.  26) ;  which 
St.  Paul  calls  "giving  thanks"  (1  Cor. 
xi.  24).  Wherefore  all  Churches  in  the 
world,  from  the  Apostles'  days,  have  used 
such  a  fonii,  the  ancient  and  essential  part 
of  which  is  the  words  of  our  Saviour's  insti- 
tution ;  for,  since  He  makes  this  sacramental 
charge,  it  hath  been  thought  fit  by  all 
churches  to  keep  His  own  words,  which 
being  pronounced  by  a  laivful  priest,  do 
properly  make  the  consecration ;  wherefore 
our  Church  has  cut  off  all  the  later  super- 
stitious additions,  by  which  the  Koman 
Church  hath  coiTupted  this  form,  and  given 
us  a  prayer  of  consecration,  consisting  onlj' 
of  the  words  of  our  Savioui^'s  institution, 
and  a  proper  prayer  to  introduce  it.  The 
first  part  is  a  prayer  directed  to  "  Almighty 
God  our  heavenly  Father,"  commemorating 
His  mercy  in  giving  His  Son  to  die  for  us, 
and  the  all-sufficient  merit  of  His  death, 
together  with  His  command  for  our  remem- 
bering it  in  this  sacrament;  and  on  these 
grounds  desiring  that,  since  we  obey  Him 
in  thus  celebrating  it,  we  may  therein 
receive  Christ's  body  and  blood.  The 
second  part  is  the  repetition  of  the  words 
and  actions  of  our  Lord  at  the  institution, 
concerning  both  the  time  and  the  manner 
of  its  institution." — Dean  Comber. 

CONSECRATION  OF  THE  WATER 
IN  BAPTISM.  (See  Baptism.)  The 
form  of  consecration  in  the  Prayer  Book 
of  1549,  began  with  this  prayer,  "  0  most 
merciful  God,  our  Saviour  Jesus  Christ, 
who  hast  ordained  the  element  of  water, 
for  the  regeneration  of  Thy  faithful  people, 
upon  Whom  being  baptised  in  the  river 
Jordan,  the  Holy  Ghost  came  down  iu 
the  likeness  of  a  dove.  Send  down,  we 
beseech  Thee,  the  same,  Thy  Holy  Spirit, 


CONSTANCE 


235 


to  assist  us,  and  to  be  present  at  this  our 
invocation  of  Thy  Holy  Name:  sanctify 
this  iji  fountain  of  baptism,  Thou  that  art 
the  sanctifier  of  all  things,  that  by  the  power 
of  Thy  word,  all  those  that  shall  be  baptized 
therein  ma}'  be  spiritually  regenerated,  and 
made  the  children  of  everlasting  adoption." 
This  was  omitted  in  1552,  the  present  words 
"sanctify  the  water"  &c.  were  added  in  1662. 

CONSECRATION  OF  SOVEREIGNS. 
(See  Coronation.') 

CONSISTBNTES.  {Co-standers.)  The 
last  order  of  penitents  in  the  primitive 
Church,  so-called  from  their  having  their 
liberty,  after  other  penitents,  energumens, 
and  catechumens  were  dismissed,  to  stand 
with  the  faithful  at  the  altar,  and  join  in 
the  common  prayers,  and  see  the  oblation 
offered ;  but  yet  they  might  neither  make 
their  own  oblations,  nor  partake  of  the 
Eucharist  with  them.  (See  Catediumens.) 
— Bingham,  bk.  xviii.  c.  1. 

CONSISTORY  (from  Low  Latin  "  consis- 
torium,"  a  place  of  assembly).  A  word  used 
to  denote  the  Court  Christian,  or  Spiritual 
Court.  In  the  Church  of  England,  before 
the  Norman  Conquest,  the  ecclesiastical  juris- 
diction was  not  separated  from  the  civil ;  for 
the  earl  and  bishop  sat  in  one  court,  that  is, 
in  the  ancient  county  court.  William  the 
Conqueror  separated  the  secular  from  the 
ecclesiastical  courts ;  and  after  that  time  every 
bishop  had  his  consistory  court,  iu  which  he 
tried  spiritual  causes,  either  in  person  or 
through  an  official  apjwinted  by  himself. 

CONSTANCE,  COUNCIL  OF.  This 
council  assembled  in  1414,  by  the  combined 
authority  of  the  emperor  and  the  pope.  It 
was  attended  by  thirty  cardinals,  three 
patriarchs,  twenty  archbishops,  one  hundred 
and  fifty  bishops,  besides  an  immense 
number  of  the  inferior  clergy.  It  included 
sovereign  princes,  electors  of  Germany,  as 
well  as  representatives  from  every  country 
in  communion  with  Rome.  Its  objects 
were,  to  jiut  an  end  to  the  Papal  schism,  to 
reform  the  Church,  and  to  put  down  the  so- 
called  heresy  of  Bohemia. 

I.  During  a  period  of  nearly  forty  years 
rival  popes  had  claimed  the  see  of  Rome. 
The  council  not  only  removed  the  two  popes 
whose  title  had  been  previously  disallowed, 
but  also  deposed  the  third,  who  had  been 
legitimately  appointed,  and  had  forfeited  his 
right  by  many  and  great  crimes,  namely, 
John  XXIII.  Martin  V.  was  appointed 
popje. 

II.  John  Huss,  who  was  a  learned  and 
eloquent  man,  of  blameless  life,  and  of  great 
influence,  arrived  at  Constance  soon  after  the 
meeting  of  the  council.  He  had  embraced 
the  opinions  of  Wiclif,  and  had  been 
especially  earnest  in  denouncing  the  avarice 
and  immoralities  of  the  priests,  as  well  as 


236 


CONSTANTINOPLE 


the  frauds  practised  upon  tlie  people  by 
pretended  miracles.  He  was  accused  and 
thrown  into  prison.  The  emperor  at  first 
expressed  great  indignation  at  his  arrest,  hut 
having  been  influenced  by  members  of  the 
council,  he  not  only  withdrew  his  protection, 
but  deputed  the  elector  palatine,  as  vicar  of 
the  empire,  to  place  him  in  the  hands  of  the 
secular  magistrate.  The  pleas  on  which 
this  breach  of  faith  have  been  defended  by 
Roman  writers  are  inconsistent  and  self- 
contradictory.  Some  endeavour  to  maintain 
that  Huss  did  not  possess  the  safe-conduct 
until  after  his  arrest ;  some,  that  he  broke 
the  conditions  on  which  it  was  granted ;  and 
some,  that  no  engagement  of  the  emperor 
could  Umit  the  authority  of  the  council.  All 
impartial  judges  have  long  been  agreed  in 
condemning  the  act  as  a  deep  and  indelible 
disgrace  to  the  Eoman  Church.  The  letters 
of  the  martyr  himself,  as  well  as  the  language 
of  his  defence,  describe  in  touching  and 
Christianly  terms  the  harshness  and  in- 
justice with  which  he  was  treated.  Having 
resisted  all  efforts  to  procure  his  recantation, 
whether  by  threats  or  persuasion,  he  was 
condemned,  and  met  his  death  with  wonder- 
ful calmness  and  heroism,  on  the  7th  July, 
1415.  The  immediate  effect  of  his  condem- 
nation, and  that  of  Jerome  of  Prague,  which 
speedily  followed,  was  to  kindle  the  flames 
of  civil  war  in  Bohemia,  during  which  the 
names  of  Wiclif  and  Huss  formed  the 
watchword  on  the  one  side,  and  that  of  the 
pope  on  the  other. 

III.  In  the  fourth  and  fifth  sessions,  the 
absolute  superiority  of  a  general  council 
over  the  pope  was  expressed  in  the  form  of 
an  exact  decree.  The  decision  of  the  council 
was  gravely  and  deliberately  adopted ;  and 
it  had  the  fullest  support  of  the  learned 
divines  who  were  present,  such  as  Cardinal 
P.  d'AUli,  who  had  been  chancellor  of  the 
university  of  Paris,  and  his  still  more  illus- 
trious pupil  and  successor,  John  Gerson, 
who,  beyond  all  other  theologians,  influenced 
and  represented  the  mind  of  that  age.  It 
has  always  furnished  an  insurmountable 
difficulty  to  controversialists  of  the  ultra- 
montane school.  They  cannot  reject  its 
authority  without  giving  up  the  legitimacy 
of  every  pope  since  Martin  V. ;  while,  on 
the  other  hand,  it  is  plainly  at  variance 
with  the  decrees  of  the  Council  of  Florence. 

Materials  for  the  history  of  the  Council  of 
Constance  are  provided  abundantly  by  the 
invaluable  collection  of  documents  made  by 
H.  Von  der  Hardt. 

CONSTANTINOPLE,  COUNCILS  OF. 
There  were  many  councils  held  at  Constanti- 
nople, the  first  of  which  was  in  the  year  336. 
It  was  convened  by  Constantino  the  Great, 
was  composed  of  bishops  from  Asia  Minor 
and  Thrace,  under  the  presidency  of  Eusebius 


CONSTANTINOPLE 

of  Nicomedia,  and  had  for  its  chief  objects 
the  expulsion  of  Athanasius  and  the  recep- 
tion into  communion  of  Arius.  (Euseb.  cont. 
Marcel,  i.  4.) 

The  most  important  -was  that  known 
by  the  name  of  the  2nd  General  Council^ 
which  was  convened  by  Theodosius  in  the 
year  38]..  On  the  accession  of  Theodosius, 
the  Churches,  particularly  of  the  East,  were 
almost  in  a  state  of  schism  one  with  another, 
in  consequence  of  the  bitterness  of  the  Arian 
controversy.  (See  Arius.)  There  were  two, 
or  even  three,  claimants  to  some  of  the  sees ; 
as,  for  instance,  that  of  Antioch,  where. 
Paulinus,  the  representative  of  the  old 
orthodox  succession,  which  was  in  com- 
munion with  Alexandria  and  the  West;, 
Meletius,  who  had  been  an  Arian,  but  after 
his  appointment  conformed  to  the  orthodox 
faith,  and  a  representative  of  the  new  Arians, 
were  in  opposition.  At  Constantinople  tho 
Arians  were  predominant,  and  Maximus 
had  been  consecrated  to  the  see  by  Peter  of 
Alexandria,  the  successor  of  Athanasius ;  but 
St.  Gregory  Nazianzen  had  gone  thither  as 
a  sort  of  missionary  bishop.  He  had  been 
appointed  by  St.  Basil  to  the  see  of  Sasima, 
but  St.  Basil's  jurisdiction  being  disputed, 
he  had  administered  the  church  of  Nazianzus 
for  his  father,  who  was  very  old,  and  was 
from  thence  summoned  to  Constantinople. 
On  the  unfounded  pretence  of  Gregory's 
uncanonical  translation  from  see  to  see, 
Maximus  grounded  his  right  to  the  episco- 
pate of  Constantinople.  The  Arians,  too,, 
were  divided  into  two  parties — the  Eunom- 
ians,  or  Eudoxians,  and  the  semi-Arians. 
The  latter  were  also  called  Macedonians, 
from  Macedonius,  who  had  been  bishop  of 
Constantinople,  but  had  been  deprived  of 
his  office  at  a  previous  council  held  in  360. 
(See  Macedonians.')  They  held  that  the 
Holy  Spirit  is  a  divine  Energy  diffused 
throughout  the  universe,  and  not  a  Person 
distinct  from  the  Father  and  the  Son.  To 
dissipate  this  sect,  and  to  promote  unity 
among  the  Churches,  the  emperor  held  this 
general  council.  Meletius  of  Antioch  at 
first  presided,  but  he  died  in  the  course  of 
the  session,  and  Gregory  Nazianzen  took 
his  place.  But  there  was  doubt  with  some 
whether  Gregory,  as  having  had  another  see, 
could  have  been  properly  appointed  bishop 
of  Constantinople.  He  therefore  resigned. 
"  If  my  election  disturbs  you,"  he  exclaimed, 
"I  will  become  Jonas:  throw  me  into  the 
sea  to  appease  the  storm,  although  I  did 
not  raise  it.  If  the  rest  would  follow  my 
example,  all  the  disorders  of  the  Church 
would  soon  be  appeased."  (Ruffin.  Hist.  xi. 
9;  Greg.  Naz.  t.  ii.  p.  770,  ed.  1828.) 
Timotheus  of  Alexandria,  and  afterwards 
Nectarius,  who  had  been  appointed  bishop 
of  Constantinople  after  great  consideration 


CONSTANTINOPLE 

and  opposition,  were  the  other  presidents. 
At  least  one  hundred  and  eighty-six  bishops 
attended,  but  of  these  thirty-six  were 
Macedonians,  and  refused  to  have  anything 
to  do  with  passing  the  canons,  so  that  the 
council  has  been  often  called  that  of  the 
150  (q.  v.).  It  defined  fully  and  perfectly 
the  doctrine  of  three  persons  in  one  God, 
which  was  onlj"^  done  in  part  by  the  Nicene 
Council.  (See  Creid,  Nicene.)  The  first 
decree  respects  the  creed  and  anathemas ; 
the  second  confines  bishops  to  their 
provinces ;  the  third  gives  the  bishop  of 
Constantinople  the  rank  of  second  patriarch ; 
and  the  four  remaining  decrees  are  com- 
paratively of  less  importance.  "  From  the 
date  of  this  council  Arianism  was  formed 
into  a  sect  exterior  to  the  Catholic  Church, 
and,  taking  refuge  among  the  barbarian 
invaders  of  the  empire,  is  merged  among 
those  external  enemies  of  Christianity, 
whose  history  cannot  be  regarded  as  strictly 
ecclesiastical."  (Newman's  Avians  of  the 
Fourth  Century,  421.)  The  professions  of 
the  council  were  confirmed  by  Theodosius  in 
a  constitution  dated  July  30,  381 ;  and  the 
Eunomians  and  Arians  were  deprived  of 
their  churches.  Though  the  Western 
bishops  attended  the  council,  the  first 
canons  were  accepted  by  Pope  Damasus, 
and  have  been  regarded  in  the  West  as 
CECumenical.  {Cod.  Theod.  xvi.  tit.  1, 1.  3; 
tit.  5,  1.  8 ;  Mansi,  iii.  353 ;  Newman's 
Fleury,  bk.  xviii.  1  ;  Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  i.  244,  312 ;  Beveridge,  Synod. 
ii.  98 ;  Clinton's  Fasti  R.  a.d.  379,  col.  4. 
For  the  "  Eunomian  heresy,"  see  Cave,  Hist. 
Lit.  L  210.) 

In  404  a  council,  if  it  may  he  so  called, 
met  at  Constantinople,  to  j  udge  with  regard 
to  St.  Chrysostom.  He  had  been  declared 
by  a  synod  packed  by  his  enemies,  and  held 
near  Chalcedon  the  year  before,  unworthy 
of  the  episcopal  office,  and  had  been  banished. 
(See  Chalcedon,  Council  of.)  The  people 
of  Constantinople,  who  were  attached  to 
their  bishop,  became  tumultuous,  and  im- 
peded the  execution  of  the  unjust  sentence. 
But  when  the  tumult  had  subsided,  the 
same  judges,  the  Egyptian  bishops,  in  order 
to  gratify  the  enmity  of  Eudoxia,  the 
wife  of  Arcadius,  the  emperor,  to  whom 
Chrysostom's  strictness  of  life  and  severity 
in  lashing  the  vices  of  the  times  was  very 
distasteful,  renewed  the  sentence  against 
him,  and  he  was  banished  to  Cucusus,  a 
remote  viUage  on  the  borders  of  Cilioia,  and 
the  lesser  Armenia.  (See  Stephens'  Life  of 
Chrysostom,  2nd  ed.  pp.  309-333 ;  Newman's 
Fleury,  bk.  xxi.,  xxxiii.  seq.) 

In  553  the  fifth  general  council  was 
held,  by  order  of  the  Emperor  Justinian, 
at  which  one  hundred  and  sixty-five  bishops 
attended,  with  Eutychius,  the  patriarch  of 


CONSTANTINOPLE 


237 


Constantinople,  as  president.  This  was  to 
confute  the  errors  of  the  Nestorians,  and  the 
matter  brought  before  the  council  was  con- 
tained in  the  "  Three  Chapters,"  a  title  which 
gave  the  name  to  the  controversy  which 
was  then  taking  place.  The  phrase  does 
not  imply  certain  acts  of  the  Council  of 
Chalcedon,  as  has  been  sometimes  supposed ; 
but  it  denoted  three  subjects  {Capitula) 
which  were  condemned  by  a  decree  of 
Justinian,  which  has  been  called  Jus- 
tinian's Creed;  (Evagrius,  Hist.  Eccl.  lib. 
iv.  c.  38.)  These  were  a  condemnation  of 
(1)  the  writings  of  Theodorus,  bishop  of 
Mopsuestia,  whom  the  decree  pronounced  a 
heretic  and  a  Nestorian  ;  (2)  the  writings  of 
Theodoret,  bishop  of  Cyrus,  not  universally, 
but  only  as  they  favoured  Nestoiianism,  and 
CyrU  of  Alexandria,  and  his  twelve  an- 
athemas; and  (3)  an  epistle  said  to  have 
been  written  by  Ibas,  bishop  of  Edessa, 
which  censured  Cyril  and  the  first  Council 
of  Ephesiis,  and  favoured  the  cause  of 
Nestorius.     (See  Nestorians.) 

To  understand  the  contest  about  the  Three 
Chapters,  it  should  be  remembered,  that  the 
Nestorians,  who  separated  the  two  natures 
of  Christ  too  much,  and  the  Eutyohians  or 
Monophysites,  who  commingle  them  too 
much,  were  the  two  extremes,  between 
which  the  orthodox  took  their  stand,  con- 
demning both.  But  the  orthodox  them- 
selves did  not  all  think  aUke.  Some,  in 
their  zeal  against  the  Nestorians,  came 
near  to  the  Monophysite  ground ;  and  these 
of  course  felt  willing  to  condemn  the  Three 
Chapters.  Others  zealous,  only  against  the 
Monophysites,  were  not  far  from  being 
Nestorians;  and  these  of  course  defended 
the  Three  Chapters ;  for  Theodorus,  Theo- 
doret, and  Ibas  had  been  leading  men  of  this 
very  character.  Hence  the  interest  shown 
by  the  Oriental  bishops  in  this  controversy. 
But  in  the  West,  where  the  Nestorian  and 
Eutychian  contests  had  been  less  severe, 
and  where  the  persons  and  writings  of  Theo- 
dorus, Ibas,  and  Theodoret  were  Uttle  known, 
the  Three  Chapters  were  felt  to  be  of  little 
consequence  except  as  the  condemning  them 
seemed  to  impair  the  authority  of  the  de- 
crees of  Chalcedon  and  to  asperse  characters 
once  held  in  veneration  in  the  Church.  It 
was  doubtless  a  most  rash  thing  in  Justinian 
to  condemn  the  Three  Chapters.  But  having 
done  it,  he  resolved  to  persevere  in  it.  The 
Church  was  agitated  long  and  severely,  and 
at  length  this  precipitate  act  of  the  emperor, 
being  sanctioned  by  the  requisite  authority, 
had  the  eflfect  of  shaping  the  creed  of  the 
Catholic  Church  from  that  day  to  this. 
The  Pope  Vigilius  was  present  in  Constan- 
tinople when  the  council  was  sitting,  but 
he  did  not  attend,  nor  would  he  at  first 
assent  to  its   decrees.      He    was   treated. 


238 


CONSTANTINOPLE 


therefore,  'with  indignity  tiy  the  emperor, 
and  sent  into  banishment ;  nor  did  he  re- 
turn till  he  had  received  the  decrees  of  the 
fifth  council.  He  then  wrote  two  documents, 
one  addressed  to  the  patriarch  of  Constanti- 
nople, signifying  his  assent.  He  died,  how- 
ever, on  his  way  home.  Pelagius,  his  suc- 
cessor, and  the  subsequent  Koman  Pontiffs, 
received  those  decrees;  but  the  AVestem 
bishops  would  not  follow  their  exami^le,  and 
some,  indeed,  on  this  account  seceded  from 
communion  with  the  Roman  Pontiff;  nor 
could  this  great  wound  be  healed  but  by 
length  of  time.  The  errors  of  Origen  had 
been  considered  in  a  synod  held  at  Constan- 
tinople in  538 ;  but  according  to  the  acts  of 
this  council,  as  they  have  come  down  to  ns, 
he  was  not  otherwise  condemned,  than  by 
having  his  name  inserted  in  the  list  of  here- 
tics, collectively  anathematized  in  the  eleventh 
anathema. — ^Mansi,  Condi,  ix.  413  seq. 

The  council  called  the  sixth  general 
council  was  convened  by  the  Emperor 
Constantius  Pogonatus  in  the  year  680.  It 
was  held  in  the  banqiaeting  hall  of  the 
Palace,  called  TruUus,  from  the  dome-shaped 
roof.  It  was  intended  to  set  at  rest  dis- 
putes which  had  arisen  on  the  "Mono- 
thelite"  theory.  This  was  shortly — that 
the  divine  and  human  natures  of  Christ 
did  not  possess  separate  Divine  and  Human 
Wills,  but  one  Will  partly  Human  and 
partly  Divine.     (See  Monoihelites.) 

On  such  a  feeble  pretext,  party  feeling 
ran  high.  The  emperor  himself  presided 
at  the  council,  and  though  at  first  but  few 
bishops  attended,  the  number  afterwards 
swelled  to  two  hundred.  All  the  great 
patriarchs  were  present.  The  result  was 
the  condemnation  of  the  Monothelites. 
Macarius,  patriarch  of  Antioch,  was  de- 
posed ;  those  who  had  followed  him  were 
likewise  condemned' as  heretics,  and  the 
doctrine  of  tivo  wills,  a  human  and  Divine, 
and  two  kinds  of  voluntary  acts  in  Christ, 
defined  and  established.  At  a  preUminary 
council  of  125  bishops  held  at  Rome  under 
Pope  Agatlio  against  the  Monothelites  the  re- 
nowned English  bishop  Wilfrid  was  present, 
and  took  home  the  acts  of  the  council  to 
be  accepted  by  the  Church  of  England  at  the 
Council  of  Hatfield. — Haddan  and  Stubbs' 
Councils,  iii.  140 ;  Eddius,  V.  WHfr.  c.  51. 

The  council  held  in  691-2  was  distin- 
guished as  the  Trullan  Council,  though  the 
sixth  council  had  been  also  held  in  the  domed 
hall.  It  was  convened  by  order  of  Justinian 
II.  (692)  with  the  object  of  settling  questions 
with  regard  to  the  external  part  of  worship, 
the  government  of  the  Church,  and  the 
conduct  of  Christians.  The  patriarchs  of 
Constantinople,  Jerusalem,  Antioch,  Alex- 
andria, and  Justiuiana,  with  more  than  200 
bishops  attended,  but  the  decisions  were  not 


CONTRITION 

approved  by  the  Roman  Pontiff",  Sergius. 
Amongst  others,  canon  5  approves  of  the  85 
apostolic  canons ;  canon  13  allows  priests  to 
live  in  wedlock  ;  canon  55  condemns  fasting 
on  Saturdays ;  canon  86  declares  the  equality 
of  the  bishops  of  Rome  and  Constantinople. 

A  council  called  by  the  Greeks  the  seventh 
general  council  was  summoned  by  Con- 
stantine  Copronymus  in  754.  This  was 
composed  of  338  bishops ;  a  greater  number 
than  had  ever  before  been  assembled.  They 
maintained  that  all  worship  of  images  was 
contrary  to  Scripture;  and  that  even  the 
use  of  images  was  of  dangerous  tendency, 
and  ought  to  be  abolished  (Cave,  Hist.  Lit.  i. 
p.  646,  seg'.).  For  the  many  other  councils 
at  Constantinople  see  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  436 
seq. ;  Stubbs'  Boames'  Mosheim,  notes,  vol.  i. 
374,  423,  460,  467,  470,  510,  558 ;  Mansi, 
Concil. ;  Beveridge's  Synod. ;  Clinton's 
Fasti ;  Cave,  Hist.  Lit.     [H.] 

CONSUBSTANTIAL.  Co-essential;  of 
the  same  substance  with  another.  Thus  we 
say  of  our  blessed  Lord,  that  he  is  consub- 
stantial  with  the  Father,  being  "of  one 
substance  with  the  Father."  The  term 
(6/iooucrtos)  was  first  adopted  by  the  fathers 
in  the  Council  of  Nicaja,  a.d.  325,  to  express 
more  precisely  the  orthodox  doctrine,  and 
to  serve  as  a  precaution  against  the  sub- 
tleties of  the  Arians,  who  admitted  every- 
thing except  the  consubstantiality,  using  a 
word  similar  in  sound,  but  veiy  different  in 
meaning,  ojioiovo-ios.  This  word  is  still  the 
distinguishing  criterion  between  the  catholic 
or  orthodox  Christian  and  the  Arian  heretic. 

CONSUBSTANTIATIOJSr.  The  Roman 
divines  fell  into  the  error  of  endeavouring 
to  explain  the  manner  in  which  our  blessed 
Lord  is  present  in  the  Eucharist.  (See 
Transuistantiation.')  Luther  and  his  fol- 
lowers, while  opposing  the  Romanists,  did 
not  much  differ  from  them  in  this  point,  only 
insisting  on  a  different  manner  of  exijlain- 
ing  the  inexplicable  mystery.  They  main- 
tained, that,  after  the  consecration  of  the 
elements,  the  body  and  blood  of  our 
Saviour  are  substantially  present  together 
with  the  bread  and  wine.  This  doctrine 
is  called  Consubstantiaiion.  They  believe 
that  the  real  body  and  blood  of  our  Lord 
are  united  in  a  mysterious  maimer,  through 
the  consecration,  with  the  bread  and  wine, 
and  are  received  with  and  under  them  in 
the  sacrament  of  the  Lord's  supper.  (See 
Eeal  Presence.) 

CONTRITION.  (See  Attrition.)  Con- 
trition has  been  defined  "  a  sorrow  for  sin, 
with  a  sincere  resolution  of  reforming."  The 
word  is  derived  from  the  Latin  conterere,  to 
break  or  bruise.  The  Psalmist  says,  "  A 
broken  and  a  contrite  heart,  0  God,  thou 
wilt  not  despise."  (Psalm  li.  17.) — Cone. 
Trident.  §  14,  c.  4. 


CONVENT 

"  Contritiou  is  not  usually  the  beginning  of 
repentance,  but  is  a  great  progression  in  it ; 
and  it  contains  in  it  obedience.  He  that  is 
attrite,  leaves  his  sin ;  but  he  that  is  contrite 
obeys  God.  and  pursues  the  interests  and  ac- 
quists  of  virtue :  so  that  contrition  is  not  only 
a  sorrow  for  having  offended  God,  whom  the 
penitent  loves ;  that  is  but  one  act  or  effect 
of  contrition ;  but  contrition  loves  God  and 
hates  sin;  it  leaves  this  and  adheres  to 
Him ;  abstains  from  evU,  and  does  good ; 
dies  to  sin  and  lives  to  righteousness ;  and 
is  a  state  of  pardon  and  acceptable  services. 
But  then  there  is  a  sorrow  also  proper  to  it. 
It  hates  sin  upon  higher  contemplations 
than  he  that  hates  it  upon  the  stock  of  fear. 
For  it  is  sorrow  proceeding  from  love." — 
Jeremy  Taylor's  Works,  vol.  ix.  p.  239, 
ed.  Hebei.     (See  Attrition.') 

CONVENT.  A  religious  house  ;  a  mon- 
astery; more  usually  used  to  signify  a 
nimuery.  For  its  architectural  arrange- 
ments, see  Monastery. 

CONVENTICLE.  The  Latin  name 
conventiculum  in  its  original  notation 
signifies  no  more  than  an  assembly,  and  is 
frequently  used  by  the  ancient  writers  for 
a  church. — Bingham,  bk.  viii.  1. 

In  England  the  word  was  first  attributed 
as  an  appellation  of  reproach  to  the  re- 
ligious assemblies  of  Wiclif.  It  is  now 
the  legal  tenn  to  denote  any  place  of  wor- 
ship used  by  those  who  depart  from  the 
Church  of  England. 

By  the  73rd  canon,  it  is  thus  ordained : 
"  Forasmuch  as  all  conventicles  and  secret 
meetings  of  priests  and  ministers  have  ever 
been  justly  accounted  very  hateful  to  the 
state  of  the  Church  wherein  they  live,  we 
do  ordain  that  no  priests  or  ministers  of 
the  Word  of  God,  nor  any  other  persons, 
shall  meet  together  iu  any  private  house, 
or  elsewhere,  to  consult  upon  any  matter  or 
course  to  be  taken  by  them,  or  upon  their 
motion  or  direction  by  any  other,  which 
may  any  way  tend  to  the  impeaching  or 
depraving  of  the  doctrine  of  the  Church  of 
England,  or  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer, 
or  any  part  of  the  government  or  discipline 
now  established  in  the  Church  of  England, 
under  pain  of  excommunication  ipso  foicto." 

CONVERSION.  A  change,  literally  a 
"  turning  round  "  of  heart  and  life  from  sin 
to  holiness.  This  change,  when  it  takes 
place  in  a  heathen  or  an  infidel,  comprises 
a  reception  and  confession  of  the  truths  of 
Christianity :  when  it  takes  place  in  a  person 
already  baptized  and  a  Christian  in  pro- 
fession, it  implies  a  saving  and  influential 
impression  on  his  heart,  of  those  truths 
which  are  already  received  by  the  mind  and 
acknowledged  with  the  lips.  To  the  heathen 
and  infidel  conversion  is  absolutely  and 
always  necessary  to  salvation.   The  baptized 


CONVOCATIONS 


239 


Christian  may  by  God's  grace  so  continue 
in  that  state  of  salvation  in  which  he  was 
placed  in  baptism  (see  Church  Catechism),, 
that  conversion,  in  this  sense,  is  not  ne- 
cessary to  him :  still  even  he,  day  by  day, 
will  fall  into  sins  of  infirmity,  and  he  will 
need  renewal  or  renovation :  and  all  these^ 
the  daily  renewal  of  the  pious  Christian,  the 
conversion  of  the  nominal  Christian,  and 
the  conversion  of  the  infidel  or  heathen — 
are  the  work  of  the  Holy  Spirit  of  God  on 
the  hearts  of  men. 

Some  persons  have  confused  conversion 
with  regeneration,  and  have  taught  that  all 
men — the  baptized,  and  therefore  in  fact 
regenerate — -must  be  regenerated  after- 
wards, or  they  cannot  be  saved.  Now  this 
is  in  many  ways  false;  for  regeneration, 
which  the  Lord  Jesus  Christ  himself  has 
connected  with  holy  baptism,  cannot  be 
repeated :  moreover,  not  all  men  (though 
indeed  most  meu  do)  fall  into  such  sin 
after  baptismj  that  conversion  or,  as  they 
tei-m  it,  regeneration,  is  necessary  to  their 
salvation;  and  if  a  regeneration  were  ne- 
cessary to  them,  it  could  only  be  obtained 
through  a  repetition  of  baptism,  which  were 
an  act  of  sacrilege.  Those  who  speak  of 
this  supposed  regeneration,  uncharitably 
represent  the  orthodox  as  denying  the  ne- 
cessity both  of  regeneration  and  of  con- 
version ;  because  they  themselves  call  these 
by  wrong  names,  and  the  orthodox  only 
proclaim  their  necessity  in  their  true  sense. 
(See  Regeneration.) 

CONVOCATIONS.  Constitution.— T^h^ 
Convocations  or  Provincial  Synods  of  Can- 
terbury and  York  are  ecclesiastical  assemblies 
severally  representing  the  Church  in  their 
respective  provinces;  and  when  acting  in 
concert  constitute,  in  the  words  of  the  139th 
Canon,  "  the  Sacred  Synod  of  this  Nation" — ■ 
"  the  true  Church  of  England  by  representa- 
tion." 

The  Provincial  Synod  of  Canterbuiy  con- 
sists of  the  Metropolitan  and  the  diocesan 
bishops  within  his  jurisdiction;  with  these 
assemble  all  deans  of  cathedrals  in  the 
province,  the  Dean  of  Westmmster,  and  the 
Dean  of  Windsor,  the  Provost  of  Eton,  all 
archdeacons  in  the  province,  one  proctor 
elected  by  each  cathedral  chapter,  a  proctor 
for  the  Westminster  Chapter  [and  old  records 
specify  a  proctor  for  Wolverhampton],  and 
two  proctors  elected  by  the  beneficed  clergy 
of  each  diocese. 

The  Provincial  Synod  of  York  in  like  man- 
ner consists  of  the  Metropolitan,  bishoiJs, 
deans  of  cathedrals,  archdeacons,  chapter 
and  clergy,  proctors  of  the  dioceses  within 
the  province — together  with  two  proctors 
for  the  officialty  of  the  Chapter  of  Durham. 
But  in  one  respect  York  differs  from  Canter- 
bury, as  two  proctors  are    elected  by  each 


240 


CONVOCATIONS 


archdeaconry  in  the  former  province,  whereas 
in  the  latter  two  are  elected  by  each  diocese. 

Territorial  Divisions.  The  ancient  terri- 
torial divisions  of  the  Chui-ch  for  her  go- 
vernment \vere  —  1.  Diocese  (napoiKia). 
2.  Provmce  (cvapxta),  a  combination  of 
dioceses.  3.  Exarchate  or  Patriarchate 
(SioiVijo-if),  a  combination  of  provinces. 
Each  division  had  its  proper  synod,  the 
Bishop  presiding  in  that  of  the  diocese, 
the  Metropolitan  in  that  of  the  province, 
the  Patriarch,  Exarch,  or  Archbishop  (for 
these  words  appear  to  have  been  used 
synonymously),  in  that  of  the  Exarchate  or 
Patriarchate. 

Of  ffioumenioal  Councils,  to  which  of 
course  the  decrees  of  all  other  synods  are 
subordinate,  it  is  not  needful  here  to  write 
a.t  any  length,  as  not  being  immediately  con- 
nected with  our  present  subject. 

Diocesan  Synods.  In  the  Diocesan  Synod 
the  bishop  sat  in  conjunction  with  all  the 
presbyters  of  his  diocese.  The  earliest  ex- 
ample we  have  is  that  mentioned  in  Acts 
xxi.  18-25  :  when  S.  James,  Bishop  of 
Jerusalem,  convened  his  presbyters,  and  at 
which  previous  decisions  of  the  Apostolic 
Council  of  Jerusalem  recorded  in  Acts  xv. 
were  enforced  and  promulged.  In  the 
primitive  Church,  though  the  bishop  had  a 
ruling  superiority,  yet,  as  we  know  from  the 
•example  of  S.  Cyprian,  he  was  wont  in  all 
weighty  matters  to  consult  his  presbyters. 
So  it  is  that  S.  Ignatius  describes  presbyters 
as  "  the  Counsellors  and  assistants  of 
Bishops,"  S.  Chrysostom  as  "  the  Court 
and  Sanhedrim  of  the  Presbyters,"  S. 
■Cyprian  as  "the  Venerable  Bench  of  the 
Clergy,"  S.  Jerome  as  "  the  Church's  Senate," 
and  Origen  as  "  the  Council  of  the  Church." 
As  the  bishop  was  thus  wont  to  sit  in 
<;omicil  with  his  presbyters,  special  places  of 
honour  were  assigned  to  them  in  those  early 
assemblies.  The  bishop  sat  in  the  centre 
on  a,  high  throne,  and'  the  presbyters  on 
•either  side  of  him  on  somewhat  lower 
thrones.  And  so  universal  was  this  custom, 
"that  the  expressions,  "  they  of  the  second 
.throne,"  or  the  "  Corona  Presbyterii,"  were 
isynonymous  with  presbyters.  Conformably 
with  these  facts,  there  is  a  vision  recorded 
by  Gregory  of  Nazianzus,  poetically  de- 
scribing his  Diocesan  Synod,  of  which  he 
writes  thus :  "  I  thought  I  saw  myself 
sitting  on  the  high  throne,  and  the  presbyters, 
that  is,  the  guides  of  the  Christian  flock, 
sitting  on  both  sides  by  me  on  lower  thrones, 
and  the  deacons  standing  by  them." 

Eecords  of  Diocesan  Synods  held  in  Eng- 
land before  the  Reformation  may  be  found 
in  the  pages  of  Wilkins's  "  Concilia  Magnaj 
Britannia},"  and  the  forms  with  [which  they 
were  celebrated  may  be  seen  in  vol.  iii.  p. 
681  of  that  work.     Since  the  Reformation 


CONVOCATIONS 

few  have  been  in  this  country  summoned  to 
meet.  Some  instances,  however,  have  oc- 
curred, as  Diocesan  Synods  were  convened 
by  Bishop  Davies  at  S.  Asaph  in  1561,  by 
Bishop  Preake  at  Norwich  about  1580,  by 
Bishop  Lloyd  at  S.  Asaph  in  1683,  by  Bishop 
Wilberforce  at  Oxford  in  1850,  by  Bishop 
Philpotts  at  Exeter  in  1851,  by  Bishop 
Wordsworth  at  Lincoln  in  1871,  and  by 
Bishop  Maclagan  at  Lichfield  in  1884.  (See 
Congress.     Diocesan  Conference.") 

Of  late  years  many  diocesan  conferences 
have  been  convened,  that  is,  mixed  assem- 
blies of  clergy  and  laity,  but  into  this  sub- 
ject, as  not  properly  connected  with  the 
present  enquiry,  it  is  not  needful  to  enter. 

Provincial  Synods. — In  an  ascending 
order  the  next  ecclesiastical  assembly  to  be 
considered  is  a  Provincial  Synod,  or  Synod 
of  combined  dioceses;  andasourConvocations 
are  of  this  character  the  subject  requires 
especial  attention.  The  ancient  forms  of 
proceeding  in  holding  provincial  sjTiods 
may  be  found  in  fall  detail  laid  down  in 
the  4th  Canon  of  the  fourth  Council  of 
Toledo.  They  are  too  long  to  be  here 
inserted,  but  are  well  worthy  of  study,  and 
may  be  seen  in  Bruns,  pp.  222  seq. 

Provincial  organization,  which  is  em- 
phatically that  of  the  Church  of  England, 
may  he  traced  to  the  earliest,  even  to 
Apostolic  times.  Timothy  is  reported  by  S. 
Chrysostom  to  have  been  entrusted  with 
the  supervision  of  the  whole  of  Proconsular 
Asia,  in  which  were  several  bishops.  And 
It  is  affirmed  by  Eusebius  that  Titus  was 
charged  with  the  oversight  of  the  Churches 
of  Crete,  and  to  have  superintended  the 
whole  island.  In  the  second  century,  there 
are  some  further  evidences  of  provincial 
organization,  and  of  metropolitical  authority 
over  diocesan  bishops.  Irena^us  of  Lyons  in 
177  superintended  the  Gallican  dioceses. 
Philip  of  Gortyna  was  styled  "Bishop  of 
all  the  dioceses  of  Crete,"  and  that  there 
was  at  that  time  more  than  one  diocese  in 
the  island  is  certain  from  the  fact  that  at 
that  time  Piaytus  was  Bishop  of  Gnossus, 
the  inevitable  conclusion  being  that  Philip 
was  Metropolitan.  Towards  the  decline  of 
the  second  century  the  plainest  proofs  of 
this  provincial  organization  and  of  metro- 
political  authority  appear,  in  one  passage 
of  Eusebius'  history  (Lib.  v.  c.  23).  Pro- 
vincial synods  were  at  that  time  convened 
to  consider  the  proper  time  for  celebrating 
the  Paschal  festivaL  And  that  historian 
informs  us  that  in  the  Synod  of  Palestine 
Theophilus  of  Cajsarea  presided,  in  that 
of  Rome  Victor,  in  that  of  Gaul  Irenaius 
of  Lyons,  in  that  of  Proconsular  Asia 
Polycrates  of  Ephesus.  This  arrangement 
of  provincial  organization  is  moreover 
canonically  authorized  by  the  33rd,  some- 


CONVOCATIONS 

times  numbered  the  35tli  of  the  Apostoli- 
cal Constitutions,  which  runs  thus : — "  The 
Bishops  of  each  Province  ought  to  own  him 
■who  is  chief  among  them,  and  own  him  as 
their  head,  and  to  do  nothing  extraordinary 
•without  his  consent,  but  each  one  those 
things  only  which  concern  his  own  parish 
{i.e.  diocese]  and  the  country  subject 
to  it."  And.  again  the  Couiicil  of  Nice 
speaks  of  the  jurisdiction  of  Metropolitans 
■as  being  settled  at  that  date,  325 :  for  the 
fifth  Canon  of  that  Council  provides  that 
twice  in  every  year  all  the  bishops  of  each 
-province  should  meet  in  Provincial  Synod. 

British  Provinces.  —  This  provincial  or- 
■ganization  was  established  here  in  England 
in  very  early  times.  There  were  originally 
three  provinces  before  the  Saxon  invasion 
A.D.  445 — 1.  London ;  2.  York ;  3.  Caerleon- 
Tipon-Usk.  Indeed  it  is  affirmed  on  high 
-authority  that  at  the  Council  of  Aries, 
■A.D.  314,  these  three  British  prelates  were 
■present, — Eestitutus  of  London,  Eborius  of 
York,  and  Adelfius  of  Caerleon-upon-Usk. 

On  the  arrival  of  Augustine  the  monk, 
about  600  A.D.,  Christians  of  the  two  first- 
named  provinces  had  been  persecuted  by  their 
-invaders  well-nigh  to  extermination.  But 
in  the  Western  province  of  Caerleon-upon- 
Usk,  or  as  sometimes  called,  S.  David's, 
Christianity  still  flourished.  This  is  plain 
from  the  fact  that  at  the  interview  at  the 
Apostle's  Oak,  between  Augustine  and  the 
-authorities  of  the  British  Church,  seven 
bishops  from  the  West  attended,  the  Bishops 
-of  Bangor,  Hereford,  Llanbadarn,  Llandaff, 
Margam,  S.  Asaph,  and  Worcester.  These 
"were  accompanied  by  many  most  learned 
•clergy ;  of  whom  one  of  the  chief  was  Dinoth, 
Abbot  of  Bangor  Iscoed.  The  points  dis- 
cussed referred  first  to  the  time  proper  for  the 
■celebration  of  the  Paschal  festival,  which  here 
•differed  from  the  Roman  calculation,  and  was 
originally  derived  from  the  Eastern  Chm^ch 
(though  a  miscalculation  had  been  made 
after  the  Council  of  Nice  by  the  Britons) ; 
secondly,  to  the  proper  form  for  the  ad- 
ministration of  Baptism ;  thirdly,  to  a  union 
■with  Augustine  for  preaching  the  Gospel  to 
the  Anglo-Saxons.  Augustine  disinclined 
the  Britons  from  accepting  his  propositions, 
first  by  his  haughty  demeanour  in  receiving 
them  as  he  was  sitting,  and  then  by  insist- 
ing on  their  obeying  him.  So  finally  they 
■declined  his  proposals,  saying  that  they 
<!ould  not  satisfy  him  "  nor  receive  him  for 
their  Archbishop."  For  the  conditions  he 
•demanded  of  them  were  not  so  much  terms 
of  brotherly  communion  as  confessions  of 
submission  and  inferiority.  "  If,"  said  he, 
■"  in  these  three  things  you  will  obey  me, 
then  will  I  bear  with  all  other  things." 
And  the  decision  of  the  assembly  was  tersely 
summed  up  in  the  words  of  Dinoth  above 


CONVOCATIONS 


?41 


mentioned,  who  said,   "Bo  it   kno-^vn  and 
without  doubt  unto  you,  that  we  all  are  and 
every  one   of   us   obedient  and  subject  to 
the  Church  of  God  and  to  the  Pope  of  Rome 
and  to  every  godly  Christian  to  love  every 
one  in  his  degree  in  perfect  charity,  and  to 
help  every  one  of  them  by  word  and  deed  to 
be  children  of  God;    and  other  obedience 
than  this  I  do  not  know  due  to  him  whom 
you  name  to  be  Pope,  nor  to  be  the  father 
of  fathers  to  be  claimed  and  to  be  demanded. 
And  this  obedience  we  are  ready  to  give 
and  to  pay  to  him  and  to  every  Christian 
continually.     Besides,    we   are   under  the 
government  of  the  Bishop  of  Caerleon-upon- 
Usk,  who  is  to  oversee  under  God  over  us 
and  to  cause  us  to  keep  the  way  spiritual." 
Indeed  to  have  transferred  their  allegiance 
to  Augustine  from  their  own  Metropolitan 
would  have  been  a  grave  offence,  for  to  the 
ancient  Metropolitan  See  of  Caerleon-upon- 
Usk   they   owed    obedience;    and   though 
that  See  had  been  removed  to  S.  David's 
about  80  years  previously,  i.e.  by  the  Council 
held  at  Llandewi  Brevi  a.d.  519,  yet  the 
ancient  title  of  Cacrleon  and  its  jurisdiction 
was  still  retained.      Not   long   after   this 
some  of  the  dioceses  of  the  Welsh  bishops 
became  subject  to  the  metropolitical   See 
of  Canterbm-y,   but   it  is   plain   that   the 
provincial  jurisdiction  was  attached  to  the 
See  of  Caerleon  or  S.  David's  through  many 
subsequent  centuries,  at  least  over  some  of 
the  Welsh  dioceses.     [But  see,  on  all  this, 
article    on   Church,  Early  British. — Ed.] 
Giraldus  Cambrensis,  a  Welshman  born,  and 
an  author  whose  evidence  on  this  point  may 
be  without  dispute  accepted,  jiroves   from 
authentic  records  that  the  Bishops  of  S. 
David's  consecrated  suffragans  and  exercised 
all  other  branches  of  metropolitical  authority 
till  the  reign  of  Henry  I.    At  that  time  Ber- 
nard, who  had  been  chaplain  to  Adelais, 
that  monarch's  second  queen,  upon  being- 
raised  to  the  See  of  S.  David's  submitted  to 
the  Metropolitan  of  Canterbury,  and  thus 
about  A.D.  1115  the  Western  province  of 
Caerleon  became  merged  into  the  Southern 
province.     The  Convocations  of  Canterbury 
and  York  are  consequently  now  the   Pro- 
vincial Synods  representing  the  Church  ex- 
isting in  England  and  Wales.     Finally,  that 
Provincial  Synods  consist  respectively  and 
exclusively  of  the  bishops  of  a    province 
with  conjoined  presbyters,   and  that   this 
was  their  constitution  from  the  earliest  ages 
of  the  Church,  is  plain  from  manifest  proofs 
too  long  to  be  here  inserted,  but  the  evidence 
is  as  clear  as  the  evidence  of  any  fact  can  be. 
Such  is  the  constitution  of  our  Convocations, 
and  has  been  from  time  immemoriaL 

Acurious  Error,  thePriemunientes  Clause. 
— A  curious  error  has  been  published,  chiefly 
by  legal  writers,  to  the  effect  that  our  Convo- 

B 


242 


CONVOCATIOJfS 


cations  were  cstaUished  by  King  Edward  I. 
Tlie  mistake  has  arisen  from  tire  fact  tliat 
he  called  the  clergy  to  Parliament  iu  order 
that  they  might  there  vote  their  subsidies, 
■which  they  had  formeriy  done  in  their 
synods.  This  he  did  by  citing  the  clergy 
to  his  Parliaments  at  Northampton  and  York 
in  1282,  and  subsequently  in  1295,  by  a 
clause  inserted  in  the  writ  which  smnmoned 
each  bishop  to  Parliament  as  a  peer  of  the 
realm.  That  clause  began  with  the  word 
"  Prjemunientes,"  a  barbarism  for  "  Prajmo- 
nentes,"  forewammg  each  bishop  to  bring 
with  him  some  clergy  to  Parliament;  and 
those  whom  he  should  so  bring  were  specified 
in  the  same  order  as  they  had  before  that 
time  attended  in  their  Convocations.  Hence 
the  error.  But  this  call  to  Parliament  is  in 
no  way  further  connected  with  our  synods. 
When  the  Sovereign  before  that  reign 
desired  a  provincial  sjaiod  to  be  convened, 
he  directed  a  writ  to  each  metropolitan  for 
such  purpose.  But  the  writ  now  in  question 
was  addressed  to  each  bishop,  citing  him 
to  attend  in  Parliament,  and  was  a  wholly 
different  instrument  and  directed  to  a  dif- 
erent  end.  Indeed  that  King  Edward  I. 
did  not  originate  our  provincial  s3'nods  is 
manifest  from  the  simple  fact,  not  to  men- 
tion earlier  proofs  which  are  abxmdant,  that 
even  in  his  o^vn  time  three  provincial  synods 
had  been  convened  under  their  present  con- 
dition before  such  call  to  Parliament  as  he 
initiated  was  ever  issued;  that  is  to  say, 
one  in  1273  and  one  in  1277  by  Archbishop 
Kilwardby,  and  one  in  1280  by  Archbishop 
Peckham.  And  it  is  at  this  point  observable 
that  Archbishop  Kilwardby's  mandates  for 
the  Provincial  Synod  of  1277  precisely,  ex- 
clusively, and  exhaustively  prescribe  the 
members  who  were  to  attend,  being  men 
exactly  the  same  as  those  who  now  con- 
stitute our  Convocations,  i.e.  the  bishops, 
the  greater  jjersons  of  the  chapter,  the 
archdeacons,  and  the  proctors  for  the  clergy. 
But  the  writ  containing  the  call  to  Parlia- 
ment by  the  "  Prasmunientes "  clause  was 
not  issued  till  long  after,  i.e.  m  the  year 
1295.  The  original  mandates  calling  to- 
jrether  the  Convocations  in  1273  and  1277 
"just  mentioned,  are  now  preserved  in  the 
diocesan  registry  at  Worcester  Cathedral 
[Keg.  Giffard,  folios  41-71],  and  have 
been  perused  by  the  present  writer.  The 
latter,  precisely  and  exactly  defining  the 
present  constitution  of  our  Convocations, 
proves  conclusively  and  incontestably  how 
unfounded  is  the  notion  that  our  Convoca- 
tions were  inaugurated  by  King  Edward  I. 
Curiously  enough,  too,  this  call  of  the  clergy 
to  Parliament  bj'  the  "  PraBmunieutes"  clause 
in  each  bishop's  writ  of  summons  to  Parlia- 
ment is  continued  to  this  hour ;  and  were 
iiny  bishop  now   to    execute    the  writ  in 


CONVOCATIONS 

accordance  with  the  Eoyal  commands,  and 
were  the  clergy  smnmoned  by  it  to  attend, 
it  would  be  interesting  to  know  what  place 
would  be  assigned  by  the  officials  to  the 
clergy  who  presented  themselves  at  th& 
doors  of  Parliament,  where  Eoyal  commands 
are  not  usually  lightly  respected. 

On  this  subject  any  curious  enquirer  may 
find  interesting  infonnation  in  a  treatise, 
"  De  modo  tenendi  parliamentum,"  signed 
R.  Duddeley,  Earl  of  Leicester  [British 
Museum  Add.  15191,  MS.  Vellum  of  the 
16th  century],  and  also  in  Bibl.  Cotton. 
Julius,  B.  4,  p.  4,  pi.  xviii.  c.  after  Arch- 
bishops' and  Bishops'  summonses,  folio  21. 

Synods  of  the  Exarchates. — The  consti- 
tution of  exarchates,  or  combinations  of 
provinces,  is  of  later  date  in  the  Church 
than  that  of  provinces.  But  at  any  rate 
as  early  as  the  beginning  of  the  4th  century 
the  territorial  division  of  exarchate  had 
been  generally  established.  As  the  bishop 
was  chief  ecclesiastical  ofiicer  in  his  diocese 
and  the  metropolitan  in  his  province,  so  the 
exarch,  patriarch,  or  archbishop  was  chief  in 
his  exarchate ;  and  under  his  presidency 
synods  of  the  exarchate  or  SioiKrjtris  were 
convened.  That  to  these  synods  of  the  ex- 
archate the  judgments  of  provincial  synods 
were  subject,  we  have  plain  proof  in  the 
6th  Canon  of  the  2nd  Qiciunenical  Council, 
which  defines  at  length  the  order  of  juris- 
diction, and  indeed  enacts  that,  in  the  case 
of  a  bishop  an-aigned,  he  shall  have  no 
apjieal  from  the  decision  of  a  synod  of  the 
exarchate,  not  even  to  an  QScumenical 
Council. 

British  Practice  in  this  respect. — This 
union  of  our  provincial  synods  into  such 
a  joint  assembly  has  been  effected  in  Eng- 
land on  many  occasions.  An  early  and 
very  notable  instance  is  that  of  the  Council 
of  Whitby  in  664,  convened  for  the  con- 
sideration of  the  introduction  of  Romish 
practices  into  the  Church  here,  and  from 
that  time  downwards  as  many  as  forty- 
five  occasions  at  least  may  be  reckoned 
when  this  nnion  has  occurred  (on  some  of 
those  occasions  a  legate  presiding),  ranging- 
to  the  year  1540,  when  the  menibers  of  the 
Canterbury  and  York  Synods  assembled 
together  in  London  for  the  investigation  of 
the  legality  of  the  marriage  of  Anne  of 
Cleves  to  King  Henry  VIIL,  and  to  the 
year  1562,  when  both  synods  united  for  the 
ratification  of  the  39  Articles,  as  appears 
from  their  heading.  The  authority  to  unite 
oirr  two  provincial  synods  into  a  synod  of 
the  exarchate  was  specially  given  to  the 
Archbishop  of  Canterbury  at  the  Council 
of  Windsor  a.d.  1072,  and  was  confirmed  by 
subsequent  synods,  as  may  be  learned  by 
consulting  the  "  Concilia  M.  B."  vol.  i.  pp., 
325,  391,  493,  and  vol.  iv.,  app.  786.     The 


CONVOCATIONS 

forms  also  of  proceeding  arc  specially  de- 
scribed in  various  parts  of  that  work,  and 
may  thus  be  condensed : — On  arriving  at  the 
church,  the  place  of  meeting  where  prepara- 
tions had  been  previously  made  by  provid- 
ing seats  rising  in  the  form  of  steps  from 
the  ground,  the  members  took  their  places 
in  defined  order.  The  Archbishop  of  Can- 
terbury as  president  occupied  the  chief  seat. 
On  his  right  hand  was  placed  the  Metro- 
politan of  York,  and  on  his  left  the  Bishop 
of  London.  Next  the  Metropolitan  of  York 
sat  the  Bishop  of  Winchester ;  but  if  the 
Metropolitan  of  York  was  absent,  then  the 
Bishop  of  London  sat  on  the  right  of  the 
Archbishop  of  Canterbury,  and  the  Bishop 
of  Winchester  on  his  left.  After  these  pre- 
lates had  taken  their  places,  the  other 
bishops  seated  themselves  according  to  the 
dates  of  their  res2:)ective  consecrations. 
These  rules  of  precedence  were  settled  in 
the  Synod  of  London  a.d.  1075,  in  accor- 
dance with  the  tenor  of  some  old  canons 
and  after  consultation  with  aged  and  ex- 
perienced men  who  could  remember  the 
ancient  practice  of  the  Anglo-Saxon  Church. 
When  all  had  been  arranged  in  their  places 
and  silence  obtained,  the  Gospel  "  I  am  the 
good  Shepherd,"  &c.,  was  read.  Collects 
were  then  offered  up  and  the  hymn  "  Veni 
Creator  "  sung.  Next  followed  the  sermon,  at 
the  end  of  which  the  Archbishop  explained 
the  cause  of  the  meeting ;  formal  business 
was  introduced  Ijy  the  officials,  and  the 
matters  thus  introduced  discussed. 

After  discussion  the  opinions  of  the 
members  were  taken,  their  decisions  reduced 
to  writing,  signed  and  sealed  by  the  Arch- 
bishop and  signed  by  the  other  members  of 
the  assembly.  Should  our  authorities  see  fit 
at  any  time  hereafter  to  unite  our  two  pro- 
vincial synods  for  any  special  purpose  in  a 
synod  of  the  exarchate,  there  may,  as  above 
stated,  be  found  ample  precedents  for  the 
regulation  of  proceedings. 

In  imitation  of  the  example  of  the  early 
Church,  when  not  merely  provincial  but 
national  interests  have  been  concerned,  the 
two  provincial  synods  of  Canterbury  and 
York  have,  as  above  described,  united  in  a 
synod  of  the  exarchate ;  but  other  methods 
have  been  adopted  to  secure  the  authority 
of  the  synodical  exarchate. 

A  second  method  has  been  to  hold  the 
two  provincial  synods  simultaneously, 
though  separately,  each  in  its  usual  place, 
for  deliberation  on  the  same  business.  This 
plan  was  pursued  when  the  Canterbury  and 
York  Synods  were  held  concurrently  and 
on  the  same  business,  the  one  at  Lambeth, 
the  other  at  Beverley,  in  1261,  and  in  our 
own  times,  when  the  revision  of  the  Eubrics 
was  simultaneously  discussed  by  those  as- 
semblies. 


CONVOCATIONS 


243 


A  third  method  for  securing  the  joint 
authority  of  our  two  provincial  synods  has 
been  to  ratify  documents  in  one  assembly 
and  then  to  transmit  them  to  the  other  for 
authorization.  This  was  the  method  adopted 
in  passing  the  decrees  abolishing  the  papal 
supremacy  (hereafter  to  be  mentioned 
specially)  in  1534 ;  in  the  enactment  of  the 
141  canons  of  1603-4 ;  in  the  enactment  of 
the  17  canons  of  1640 ;  and  more  recently  in 
our  own  times,  when  the  articles  of  clergy 
subscription  in  the  36th  and  other  Canons 
were  remodelled  and  re-enacted. 

A  fourth  method  has  been  for  the  Metro- 
politan and  bishops  of  the  Northern  Pro- 
vince, together  with  deputies  from  the 
lower  house  of  their  synod,  to  attend  at  the 
Southern  Sjmod  and  there  to  unite  in  joint 
deliberations.  This  was  the  case  in  the 
authorization  of  our  present  Prayer  Book, 
when  the  Northern  Metropolitan  and 
bishops  and  six  delegates  for  York  attended 
the  Canterbury  Synod  in  London.  To  the 
act  of  authorization  ratifying  that  book  their 
signatures,  appended  on  December  20, 1661, 
appear  after  those  of  the  Archbishop,  bishops 
and  clergy  of  the  Canterbury  Synod.  In 
the  report  of  the  late  Ritual  Commission 
the  signatures  "  in  extenso  "  are  nominally 
printed. 

Proper  Functions  of  Convocations. — 
The  proper  functions  of  provincial  synods, 
and  such  as  have  been  exercised  by  them 
in  the  Church  of  England,  may  generally 
be  ranked  under  five  heads :  1.  Prescrij^ 
tion  of  the  Canon  of  Scripture.  2.  Promul- 
gation of  symbols  of  doctrinal  belief.  3. 
Condemnation  of  heretical  tenets.  4.  En- 
actment of  Canons.  5.  Authorization  of 
liturgical  formularies. 

(I.)  So  early  as  in  the  84th  of  the  Apostolic 
Canons,  and  in  the  60th  Canon  of  the  Synod 
of  Laodicea,  we  find  prescriptions  of  the 
Scriptural  Canon ;  and  so  late  as  at  the  Con- 
vocation of  both  our  provinces  held  in 
London  in  1562,  we  find  the  Canonical 
Scriptures  defined  by  the  6th  of  the  39 
Articles  then  ratified. 

(II.)  The  promulgation  of  symbols  of  doc- 
trinal belief,  one  of  the  prime  duties  of  synods 
in  all  ages,  was  a  function  here  exercised 
when  the  8th  Article  of  the  Church  of 
England  was  synodically  adopted  and  pro- 
mulged,  wliich  specifies  the  Three  Creeds  as 
symbols  of  faith,  which  "ought  thoroughly 
to  be  received  and  believed." 

(III.)  The  condemnation  of  heretical  tenets' 
by  provincial  synods  is  a  duty  which  has 
been  discharged  by  them  continually  in 
past  ages,  as  our  early  ecclesiastical  records 
abundantly  prove ;  and  so  late  as  in  Queen 
Anne's  time,  on  application  being  made  to 
the  judges  of  the  civil  courts  on  this  subject, 
eight  out  of  the  twelve,  together  with  the 

E  2 


244 


COKVOCATIONS 


Attorney-  and  Solicitor-general,  decided  tliat 
this  was  a  proper  part  of  the  functions  of 
our  Convocations.  It  was  then  exercised  by 
the  synodical  condemnation  of  Whiston's 
book,  and  on  a  late  occasion  in  this  genera- 
tion by  the  condemnation  of  Dr.  Colenso's 
volume  on  "  The  Pentateuch,"  &c.,  and  of 
the  book  entitled  "  Essays  and  Reviews." 

(IV.)  The  next  office  of  provincial  synods 
. — the  enactment  of  Canons — requires  rather 
fuller  consideration  on  account  of  some  pecu- 
liarities in  this  country  which  affect  such 
proceedings.  Before  the  year  1534,  our  pro- 
vincial synods  enacted  Canons  at  their  will. 
In  that  year  the  Statute  25  Henry  VIII. 
19  was  passed,  which  enacted  that  Canons 
might  not  be  here  "enacted,  promulged, 
executed  or  put  in  m-e  "  without  a  licence 
from  the  Sovereign.  The  proceedings  in 
such  a  case  are  now  as  follows.  First  the 
synod  debates  the  subject-matter  of  the 
proposed  Canon  or  Canons.  Drafts  made 
of  the  conclusions  arrived  at  are  then  sub- 
mitted to  the  Crown.  If  the  Sovereign 
approves  of  the  proposals,  a  licence  issues 
to  "  enact."  On  the  receipt  of  this  instru- 
ment the  synod  meets,  and  the  Canons 
proposed  are  engrossed  on  parchment.  In 
the  presence  of  the  whole  assembly,  both 
houses  being  joined  in  session  for  the  pur- 
pose, the  Metropolitan,  standing,  holds  the 
parchment  in  his  right  hand ;  the  Prolo- 
cutor, standing  on  his  left  side,  holds  it  with 
his  left  hand.  The  contents  are  then  read 
out  by  the' Metropolitan,  and  the  document 
being  placed  on  the  table,  is  signed  first  by 
himself,  then  by  the  provincial  bishops 
present,  and  lastly  in  order  by  the  assembled 
clergy.  Such  Canons  are  thus  "  enacted " 
and  become  law.  No  parliamentary  ap- 
proval IS  constitutionally  required,  and 
they  are  "  promulged "  to  be  "  executed 
and  put  in  ure  "  by  the  ecclesiastical  judges 
in  ecclesiastical  courts;  and  their  judg- 
ments founded  on  such  Canons  will  be  sus- 
tained by  the  civil  courts  so  long  as  the  con- 
tents do  not  contravene  Eoyal  prerogative, 
common  or  statute  lavv.  The  above  was 
the  course  taken  a  few  years  since  when  the 
36th  Canon  and  others  were  remodelled. 

(V.)  The  last  general  duty  to  be  men- 
tioned of  provincial  sjmods  is  the  author- 
ization of  Liturgies  and  Ritual.  In  earlier 
times,  and  indeed  in  this  country,  liturgies 
sometimes  varied  in  different  dioceses  of  the 
same  province,  as  is  testified  by  the  difierent 
"  Uses"  which  here  prevailed.  But  it  was 
perhaps  more  common  in  the  Church  that 
each  province  or  combination  of  dioceses 
should  conform  to  one  use,  and  measures 
for  this  purpose  were  at  times  taken,  as 
history  testifies.  At  the  Reformation  this 
latter  principle  was  extended  in  England, 
and  the   first  Prayer  Book  of  1549   was 


CONVOCATIONS 

issued  for  the  use  of  both  provinces.  The 
compilers  were  certainly  all  members  of 
Convocation,  but  the  records  ot  the  Canter- 
bury Synod  having  been  burnt  in  the 
disastrous  fire  in  London  in  1666,  the 
authentic  records  ot  the  authorization  of  the 
first  reformed  Prayer  Book  are  not  forth- 
coming. Trustworthy  historians,  however, 
do  not  doubt,  but  on  the  contrary  positively 
assert,  that  it  had  convocational  sanction. 
The  second  reformed  Prayer  Book  was  dis- 
tinctly authorized  by  the  35th  Article  of 
1552 ;  and  our  present  Prayer  Book,  compiled 
from  the  earlier  ones  mth  additions,  had  the 
sanction  of  both  our  provincial  synods  in 
1661,  as  above  mentioned,  given  in  the  most 
formal  and  emphatic  manner  imaginable, — 
that  is,  by  the  personal  signatures  of  all  the 
members  of  the  Canterbury  Synod,  fortified 
by  the  signatures  of  the  Northern  prelates 
and  six  of  the  delegates  deputed  by  that 
synod  to  attend  in  London. 

One  jurisdiction  which  has  been  con- 
ferred on  our  provincial  synods  is  a  peculiar 
one,  not  common  to  synods  of  the  Church 
generally,  but  here  consequent  on  two 
statutes  of  the  realm — 24  Hen.  VIII.  12, 
as  confirmed  by  25  Hen.  VIII.  19.  By 
the  9th  section  of  the  first-mentioned  Act, 
as  confiimed  by  the  3rd  section  of  the 
second  and  subsequently  ratified  by  1  Eliz. 
1,  it  was  enacted  that  in  all  ecclesiastical 
cases  "touching  the  King"  an  appeal 
should  lie  to  the  Upper  House  of  Convoca- 
tion of  the  province  in  which  the  cause 
arose,  and  thither  onl}'.  Such  causes  cer- 
tainly came  under  convocational  juris- 
diction in  the  cases  of  the  divorces  of 
Catharine  of  Arragon,  Anne  Boleyn,  and 
Anne  of  Cleves.  Notwithstanding  the 
decisions  of  the  Courts  of  Q.  B.  and  C.  P. 
in  the  Gorham  Case  that  this  jurisdiction 
has  been  superseded,  it  is  impossible  to 
reconcile  such  a  conclusion  with  the  tenns 
of  the  statutes  above  quoted,  and  it  is 
moreover  quite  contradictory  to  the  positive 
assertions  of  our  text  writers — Dyer,  Bacon, 
Comyn,  Woodeson,  Blackstone,  Aylifie,  and 
Burn — who  ■with  one  voice  affirm  that  the 
jurisdiction  was  never  abolished.  More- 
over it  is  within  the  certain  knowledge  of 
the  writer  of  these  lines  that  in  the  opinion 
of  some  of  our  highest  legal  authorities  of 
the  present  day,  the  forementioned  decisions 
of  two  of  our  law  courts  should  be,  to  say 
the  least,  carefully  reconsidered.  It  is 
manifest  that  the  above  jurisdiction  might 
be  a  great  safeguard  to  the  Church  in  the 
case  of  a  man  of  unsound  doctrine  being 
nominated  to  a  bishopric  or  a  benefice  in 
the  gift  of  the  Crown. 

Methods  of  Proceeding. — Previously  to 
the  year  1534,  when  the  Act  25  Hen.  VIIL 
19  was  passed,  each  Metropolitan  in  Eng- 


CONVOCATIONS 

land  could  convene  his  Provincial  Sj'nod  at 
any  time  he  thought  fit;  but  by  that 
statute  it  became  necessary  that  a  writ 
from  the  Crown  should  issue  before  the 
convocation  of  such  an  assembly.  Such  a 
writ  to  each  Metropolitan  is  always  now 
issued  from  the  Crown  Office  acourse  with 
the  writs  for  the  assembling  of  Parliament, 
and  directs  him  to  call  together  his  Synod 
on  the  next  day  after  the  meeting  of  the 
former  body.  Each  Metropolitan  .then 
directs  his  mandate  (in  Canterbury  through 
the  Bishop  of  London)  to  the  several 
bishops  within  his  jurisdiction,  warning 
them  to  attend  with  the  clergy  of  their 
diocese,  as  first  above  detailed,at  a  specified 
time  and  place.  So  long  as  the  Parliament 
sits,  the  Metropolitans  may  call  together 
their  Provincial  Synods  as  often  as  they 
please.  \Vhen  Parliament  is  iirorogued, 
the  Synods  by  Eoyal  writ  are  also  at  the 
same  time  generally  prorogued,  though  not 
necessarily  so,  as  was  decided  by  the  judges 
in  Charles  I.'s  time.  But  there  is  this 
distinction  between  the  practice  of  the 
two  bodies :  Parliamentary  committees  do 
not  meet  out  of  session;  the  Convocation 
committees  meet  at  any  time,  whether  the 
parent  body  is  in  session  or  not.  And  it  is 
in  these  committees  that  the  real  work  of 
the  synods  is  mainly  done. 

The  Canterbury  Provincial  Synod  has 
been  for  many  years  summoned  to  meet 
first  at  S.  Paul's  Cathedral  by  the  Arch- 
bishop's mandate.  On  their  assembly  the 
proceedings  are  as  follows : — The  members. 
Tested  in  their  proper  habiliments,  pass  from 
the  chapter-house  in  formal  procession  to 
the  choir  of  the  cathedral.  A  Latin  Litany 
is  read  by  the  junior  bishop,  and  an  anthem 
sung  by  the  choir.  A  Latin  sermon  is  then 
preached  by  a  member  appointed  by  the 
Archbishop.  After  sermon  the  members 
of  the  lower  house  retire  to  one  of  the  side 
chapels  for  the  election  of  a  prolocutor,  who 
on  being  presented  to  the  Archbishop  at 
a  subsequent  session,  if  approved  of  by  him 
(and  there  is  no  instance,  so  far  as  the  writer 
is  aware,  of  disapproval),  becomes  chairman 
of  the  lower  house,  and  not  only  there  pre- 
sides, but  is  the  channel  of  communication 
between  the  two  houses,  carrying  messages 
from  the  upper  to  the  lower,  and  reporting 
the  proceedings  of  the  lower  to  the  upper. 

This  separation  of  the  provincial  synods 
respectively  into  two  houses  does  not  date 
from  any  remote  antiquity.  It  seems  to  have 
originated  about  the  end  of  the  fourteenth 
or  the  beginning  of  the  fifteenth  century. 
The  practice  was  at  first  adopted  only  on 
special  occasions,  but  in  later  times,  at  least 
in  the  Canterbury  province,  has  become  the 
rule,  not  the  exception.  After  the  election 
of  the  prolocutor,  the  Convocation  is  then 


CONVOCATIONS 


245 


prorogued.  Through  many  ages  the  subse- 
quent sessions  were  usually  held  at  S. 
Paul's  until  Oliver  Cromwell's  cavalry  defaced 
the  goodly  chapter-house  there.  Now  the 
synod  is  prorogued  to  Westminster  Abbey. 
Of  late,  on  assembling  there.  Holy  Commu- 
nion has  been  administered  to  the  members  in 
Heniy  VII.'s  Chapel,  and  at  the  conclusion 
of  the  service  the  whole  Synod  meets  in 
the  Jerusalem  Ciiamber  within  the  Abbey 
precincts.  The  Archbishop  there  addresses 
them  on  any  subject  which  to  him  may 
seem  expedient,  and  then  retires  with  his 
suffragans  forming  the  upper  house  to  the 
Bounty  Board  Office  in  Dean's  Yard,  West- 
minster, where  their  sessions  are  held, 
leaving  the  members  of  the  lower  house  in 
the  Jerusalem, Chamber. 

Proceedings  in  Lower  House  of  Canter- 
hury. — At  each  of  the  sessions  of  the  Lower 
House  of  Canterbury,  which  are  held  some- 
times in  the  Jerusalem  Chamber,  sometimes 
in  the  Westminster  College  Hall,  the  Latin 
Litany  is  first  read.  The  roll  of  the  members 
is  then  called  over — a  process  denominated 
"  pra3conization,"-^— when  those  present  answer 
to  their  names.  Except  on  the  first  day  of 
a  group  of  sessions,  the  proceedings  of  the 
previous  dfiy  having  been  fairly  transcribed 
are  then  read  by  the  actuary,  i.e.  the 
officer  entrusted  with  the  documents  of  the 
assembly,  and  by  a  vote  of  the  house 
reduced  to  Acts ;  but  on  the  last  day 
of  a  group  of  sessions  this  is  done  on  the 
evening  of, the  day  itself..  The  prolocutor 
afterwards  nominates  some  members,  usua.lly 
about  six  or  eight,  as  his  assessots,  who, 
accompany  him,  whenever  he  proceeds  to 
the  upper  house,  and  who  are  also  consulted 
by  him,  if  he  so  desires,  should  any  doubtful 
question  arise  touching  the  proceedings  of 
the  assembly.  Notices  of  motion  are  then 
given,  and'  petitions  and  "  gravamina " 
presented.  As  regards '  the  presentation  of ' 
a  gravamen — which  is  ^  practice  of  the 
■highest  antiquity — it  is  the  statement  of  any 
grievance  touching  the  Church  to  which' the 
member  presenting  desires  to  call  attention, 
and  to  it  is '  usually  appended  a  "  refor- 
mandum ; ''  that  is,  a  suggestion:  for  the 
correction  of  the  evil.  Such,  a  document 
may  be  dealt  with  in  four  different  ways : 

1.  It  may  be  signed,  only  by  the  presehter ; 

2.  or  tnay  receive  the  signatures  of  as  many 
members  as  agree  with  it,  and  so  in  either 
case  be  carried  by  the  prolocutor  to,  the 
upper  house;,  3.  or  it  may  be  referred  by 
a  vote  of  the  house  to  either  of  the  com- 
mittees who  are  sitting  On  the  subject  it 
involves;  4.  or  by  such  vote  it  may  be 
discussed  with  a  view  to  its  being  made 
an  "articulus  cleri,"  that  is,  an  act  of 
the  lower  house,  and  so  be  transmitted  to 
the  upper.     Then  follow  the  debates  arising 


246 


CON.VOCATIONS 


either  from  messages  sent  from  the  upper 
house,  or  upon  motions  after  proper  notice 
of  individual  members;  but  business  sent 
from  the  upper  house  always  takes -pre- 
cedence. Each  day's  sitting  is  termed  a 
.  separate  session,  and  each  day  a  prorogation 
of  the  whole  synod  takes  place  in  the  upper 
house,  and  is  formally  communicated  to  the 
lower.  When  the  Convocation  meets  for 
several  da3fs  consecutively,  it  is  termed  a 
group  of  sessions. 

York  Gonvocation. — There  is  no  pecu- 
liarity on  which  it  is  needful  to  dilate  in 
the  proceedings  of  the  York  Convocation 
differing  from  the  above,  save  that  there  the 
two  houses  have  usually  deliberated,  at  least 
of  late,  in  one  body,  it  being  not  the  rule 
but  the  exception  to  separate,  and  it  is  a 
grave  question  whether  Canterbury  might 
not  profit  by  the  York  example. 

Separation  into  two  Houses. — ^For,  as  was 
remarked  above,  the  separation  into  two 
houses  does  not  date  from  very  high 
antiquity.  Indeed  it  is  plain  from  the 
history  of  the  earlier  ages  of  the  Church 
that  while  the  "  Corpus  Syuodi"  was  in  the 
Bishops,  yet  that  those  who  were  below  the 
episcopal  order  united  with  them  in  common 
deliberation,  and  on  some  occasions  at  least 
were  by  their  learning  and  eloquence  the 
chief  champions  in  debate.  Striking  ex- 
amples of  this  may  be  found  in  the  records 
of  places  and  ages  ividely  different.  Thus  at 
the  Council  of  Antioch  in  the  third  century 
Malchion  was  chief  speaker,  and  as  Eusebius 
writes  (Eccles.  Hist.  vii.  29),  "he  alone 
prevailed  to  detect  the  subtle-minded  man," 
when  Paulus  Samosatenus  was  delated  for 
false  teaching.  At  Nice,  in  the  fourth 
century,  Athanasius  was  chief  champion  of 
the  orthodox  faith.  At  our  National 
Council  of  Whitby,  in  the  seventh  century, 
Wilfrid  was  chief  speaker,  and  from  the 
result  appears  to  have  been  the  most  effectual 
advocate.  But  neither  Malchion,  Athana- 
sius, or  Wilfrid  were  bishops  on  the  occasions 
referred  to. 

To  come  much  nearer  to  our  own  times, 
it  is  to  the  learning  and  eloquence  of  a 
presbyter  in  the  Canterbury  Synod  that  the 
Church  of  England  is  deeply  indebted  for 
the  preservation  of  her  Liturgy  in  its 
integrity.  In  King  William  the  Third's 
reign,  endeavours  were  made  under  Dutch 
influence  and  with  the  sanction  of  courtier 
bishops  to  puritauize  the  English  Prayer 
Book.  It  was  the  brilliant  and  touching 
address  of  Dr.  Jane  (then  prolocutor  of  the 
lower  house),  wliich  he  wound  up  with  the 
historical  words  of  the  Barons  of  old  time 
— "  nolumus  leges  Angliaj  mutari " — that 
in  great  measure  prevailed  to  sway  that 
assembly  and  avert  the  catastrophe. 

Method  of  appointing  Preshyters  to  the 


CONVOCATIONS 

English  Provincial  Synods. — In  the  ap- 
pointment of  Presbyters  as  members  of 
our  Convocations,  a  practice  must  here  be 
referred  to  which  seems  to  be  peculiar  to 
England.  In  early  times  the  Presbyters 
who  attended  Church  Councils  were  ap- 
pointed by  their  respective  Bishops.  Thus 
in  the  "  Tractori.-E  "  or  letters  of  summons 
directed  to  Chrestus,  Bishop  of  Syracuse,  and 
calling  him  to  attend  the  Council  of  Aries 
(a.d.  314),  he  is  commanded  to  bring  with 
him  "  two  of  the  second  throne,"  i.e.  two 
presbyters.  And  this  appears  to  have 
been  the  ancient  practice.  But  in  England 
proctors .  are  elected  by  the  Cathedral 
Chapters  and  parochial  clergy.  When  this 
practice  first  arose  is  a  question  not  easy  of 
solution;  but  at  any  rate  such  elected 
proctors  are  mentioned  in  a  mandate  of 
Archbishop  Kilwardby  summoning  his  Pro- 
vincial Synod  in  1277,  and  also  in  a  Canon 
of  the  Council  of  Reading  in  1279. 

Condensed  Summary  of  some  inemoraile 
Acts  of  our  Convocations. — ^I'he  Acts  of  our 
Convocations  are  recorded  in  the  folios  of 
Lyndwood  and  Spelman,  and  in  the  ele- 
phantine tomes  of  the  "  Concilia  Magnas 
Brittannise"  edited  by  Wilkins  at  the  be- 
ginning of  the  last  century.  These  immense 
columns  may  fairly  daunt  the  most  per- 
severing student ;  but  they  are  full  of  in- 
formation respecting  the  history  of  the 
Church  of  England,  which  well  repays 
labour,  and  which  gives  an  aspect  to  that 
history  very  different  from  that  presented  by 
most  of  our  historians.  These  writers  have 
studied  Acts  of  Parliament  carefully  enough, 
but  the  Acts  of  our  Synods  have  for  the  most 
part  been  wholly  overlooked  and  absolutely 
ignored.  On  comparison  of  dates  it  will  be 
found  that  in  the  most  important  ecclesiastical 
matters.  Acts  of  our  Synods  have  preceded 
the  enactment  of  statutes  on  ecclesiastical 
subjects,  so  that  the  latter  were  merely  the 
embodiment  and  civil  ratification  of  what 
synodical  authority  had  previously  deter- 
mined. 

Before  the  dawn  of  the  Eefonuation  the 
recorded  Acts  of  our  Convocations  mostly 
pertain  to  the  enactment  of  Canons  and  the 
trial  of  heretics  and  heretical  opinions. 
After  that  date  the  information  contained 
in  the  records  of  the.  Con  vocations  becomes 
of  the  highest  interest,  as  it  gives  the  tnie 
estimate  of  the  prevailing  part  which  they 
took  in  that  movement. 

The  chief  corner-stone  of  the  Reforma- 
tion, from  an  ecclesiastical  point  of  view, 
was  laid  by  the  Convocations  of  Canterbury 
and  York  in  the  year  1534.  On  March  31, 
in  that  year,  the  Canterbury  Convocation, 
with  only  four  dissentients  in  the  lower 
house,  and  on  May  5  the  Convocation  of 
York  unanimously,  decreed  that — 


CONVOCATIONS 

"  The  Pope  op  Home  has  ko  greater 
jurisdiction  conferbed  on  him  by  god 
IN  HOLY  Scripture  in  this  kingdom  of 
England  than  any  other  foreign  bishop  " 
<Cono.  Mag.  Britt.  iii.  769,  and  Wake's 
MSS.  Ch.  Ch.  Libraiy,  ad  ami.  lo3i). 

Thus  by  the  formal  decrees  of  our  two 
Convocations  the  Papal  Supremacy  in 
England  was  discharged,  and  thus  the 
primitive  independence  of  the  British 
Church  was  syuodically  restored. 

Thus  was  the  principle  here  vindicated, 
which  is  distinctly  asserted  by  Canon  VI. 
of  the  First  Ecumenical  Council  (Nice), 
when    the     primitive    independence     and 
rights    of   the  Egyptian,   Libyan,   Penta- 
liolitan,  and  Antiochian  provinces  were  con- 
firmed as  being  in  conformity  with    the 
"  ancient  customs   which  should   prevail." 
This  principle  was  again   re-affirmed    by 
Canon  II.  of  the  Second  Ecumenical  Coun- 
cil  (Constantinople   I.),   the  words    being 
as    follow ; — "  Let    no   Bishops  go  beyond 
their    dioceses    [exarchates]    to    churches 
beyond     their    bounds    nor     disturb    the 
churches,  according  to  the  Canons.     Let  the 
Bishop  of  Alexandria  administer  the  affairs 
of  Egypt,  and  the  Bishops  of  the  East  govern 
the  East  alone,  the  rights  and  privileges  of 
the  Church  of  Antiocli  sanctioned  in  the 
Nicene  Canons  being   preserved  inviolate. 
Let  the  Bishops  of  the  Asian  diocese  [exar- 
chate]  administer  the  Asian   affairs  onlj-, 
and  the  Bishops  of  the  Pontic  diocese  the 
affairs  of  Pontus  only,  and  they  of  Thrace 
the  affairs   of  the   Thracian   diocese  only. 
But  let  not  Bishops  go  out  of  their  diocese 
for  ordination  or  any   other   ecclesia-stical 
administration  uninvited.     The  superscribed 
Canon  touching  the  dioceses  being  observed, 
it  is  manifest  that  in   each  province   the 
Synod  of  the  Province  will  rule  according 
±0  the  decrees  which  were  defined  at  Nice." 
This  governing  principle  is  known  in  eccle- 
siastical history  as  the  Jus  Cyprium,  con- 
fii-med  by  Canon  VIII.  of  the  Third  OEcu- 
menical  Coxmcil  (Ephesus),   as  quoted  bj^ 
ihigh   authorities,   and   which    runs    thus : 
"  The  same  rule  shall  be  observed  in  all 
other  dioceses  and  provinces  whatsoever,  so 
that  no  bishop  shall  occupy  another  pro- 
vince which  has  not  been  subject  to  him 
from  the  beginning;   and  if  he  shall  have 
made  any  such  occupation  or  seizure,  let 
him  make   restitution,  lest  the  Canons  of 
the  Holy  Fathers  be  transgressed,"  &c. 

The  chief  comer-stone  of  this  Reforma- 
tion having  been  thus  synodically  laid  by 
our  Convocations  in  the  matter  of  jurisdic- 
tion, it  is  interesting  to  trace  how  in  matters 
of  doctrine,  ritual,  and  discipline  the  Refor- 
mation was  carried  on  by  degrees  and  finally 
completed  by  that  same  authoritj'.  The 
progress  can  only  be  set  down  here  in  brief ; 


CONVOCATIONS 


247 


the  lengthened  proofs  from  the  convoca- 
tional  and  from  trustworthy  records  could  be 
in  each  case  supplied  did  space  permit. 

In  the  reign  of  King  Henry  VIIL,  Con- 
vocations compiled  or  sanctioned  in  1536 
the  Ten  Articles  of  that  year.  In  1537,  the 
"  Institution  of  a  Christian  Man."  In  1542, 
"  the  New  and  Expurgated  Edition  of  the 
Sarum  Use."  In  1543,  "the  Necessary 
Doctrine  and  Erudition  of  any  Christian 
Man."  In  1544,  "th?  English  Reformed 
Litany."  In  the  reign  of  Edward  VI.,  in 
1547,  the  authority  "to  administer  the 
Communion  in  both  kinds."  In  the  same 
year  "  the  Abrogation  of  the  Ccelibacy  of  the 
Clergy."  In  1548,  "  the  Order  of  the  Com- 
munion.'' In  1549,  "  the  First  Reformed 
Prayer  Book."  In  1552-3, "  the  Second  Re- 
formed Prayer  Book."  In  the  same  year, 
"the  42  Articles  of  1552-3,"  the  35th  of 
which  sanctioned  the  book  last  mentioned ; 
and  in  the  reign  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  1563, 
N.S.,  the  present  39  Articles  of  Religion,  at 
which  date  the  English  Reformation  may 
be  said  to  have  culminated. 

It  is  here  observable  that  the  Committee 
of  Divines  appointed  to  draft  the  "  Order  of 
the  Communion "  in  1548  was  composed 
entirely  and  exclusively  of  members  of  the 
Convocations  of  Canterbury  and  York. 
This  appears  fiom  the  styles  and  titles  of 
all  save  two,  i.e.  Robertson  and  Redmayn. 
But  the  first  was,  we  know  from  other 
evidence.  Archdeacon  of  Leicester  at  the 
time,  and  that  the  latter  was  a  member  we 
learn  from  the  fact  that  he  is  represented  as 
having  delivered  liis  opinion  in  writing  pre- 
viously on  the  subject  of  the  celibacy  of  the 
clergy,  because  he  was  not  in  his  place  at 
the  session  of  Convocation  in  which  that 
matter  was  debated.  The  committee  which 
afterwards  compiled  the  first  reformed  Prayer 
Book  was  smaller  than  the  committee  which 
compiled  the  "  Order  of  the  Communion," 
but  was  composed  exclusively  of  persons 
who  had  served  on  the  earlier  committee. 
Thus  plainly  both  the  committees  above 
mentioned  which  compiled  these  reformed 
Offices  were  composed  exclusively  of  mem- 
bers of  Convocation.  So  unfounded  is  the 
notion  that  these  committees  were  merely 
Royal  Commissions. 

Passing  onwards  in  chronological  order 
after  the  Reformation  settlement,  some  me- 
morable Acts  of  the  Convocations  were  as 
follows.  In  Q.  Elizabeth's  reign  the  trial 
of  Hilton  for  heresy  in  1584,  the  enactment 
of  articles  of  discipline  in  1585,  and  of  the 
twelve  constitutions  in  1597-8.  In  King 
James  I.'s  reign,  the  enactment  of  the  141 
Canons  of  1603-4,  and  the  trial  of  Crashaw 
for  false  doctrine  in  1610.  In  King  Charles 
I.'s  reign,  the  enactment  of  the  17  Canons 
of  1640.     In  King  Charles  II.'s  reign,  the 


248 


CONVOCATIONS 


revision  aud  syiaodical  authorization  of 
our  present  Prayer  Book  in  1661.  In 
King  William  III.'s  reign,  the  rejection  of 
the  "  Comprehension  Liturgy,"  which  would 
have  reduced  the  Prayer  Book  to  a  puritan 
standard,  and  was  proposed  by  that  monarch 
and  some  of  his  sycophant  bishops  in  1689. 
On  this  occasion  it  is  observable  that  a 
joint  address  of  both  Houses  of  Parliament 
was  presented  to  the  CroAvn  requesting  that 
Convocation  should  be  consulted  "  according 
to  the  ancient  practice  and  usage  of  this 
kingdom."  In  Queen  Anne's  reign,  a  letter 
of  business  from  her  Majesty  having  been 
directed  to  the  Archbishop  Tenison  express- 
ing a  desire  that  Convocation  would  repress 
loose  principles,  Whiston's  book,  "  An 
Historical  Preface,"  &c.,  was  brought  before 
the  Canterbury  Convocation  and  synodically 
condemned  in  1711.  The  above  brief  sum- 
mary of  some  events,  which  it  would  require 
volumes  to  describe  in  full,  will  suggest 
what  are  the  proper  functions  of  our  Convo- 
cations, what  duties  they  have  discharged  in 
past  times,  what  engagements  are  proper 
for  them  now,  and  what  will  continue  to  be 
so  while  the  Church  of  England  abides  in 
her  pristine  character. 

Suspension  of  Convocational  Action. — In 
the  year  1716,  Hoadley,  Bishop  of  Bangor, 
published  a  book  entitled  "The  Preser- 
vative," &c.,  and  in  the  year  foUowiug 
preached  a  sermon  before  King  George  I.  at 
S.  James's.  Both  book  and  sennon  were 
accused  of  false  doctrine,  and  were  so 
charged  before  the  Canterbury  Synod  in 
1717.  A  warm  controversy,  known  as  the 
Bangorian  controversy,  was  kindled,  and 
the  Whig  Government  of  the  day  was 
induced  for  the  time  to  suspend  convoca- 
tional action  by  prorogation  on  the  14th 
February,  1718.  From  that  date  synodical 
action  of  any  importance  was  suspended 
down  to  the  year  1852 ;  for  though  Convo- 
cations met  and  transacted  some  business  in 
1728  and  1741,  yet  their  meetings  were 
generally,  in  the  interval  above  named, 
merely  pro  forma.  They  did  indeed 
assemble  contemporaneously  with  the  meet- 
ing of  every  Parliament,  solemnly  opened 
their  sessions,  formed  a  lower  house,  elected 
a  prolocutor,  and  were  then  dismissed, 
being  continued  from  time  to  time  by 
prorogations  of  the  Metropolitan.  The 
blame,  however,  of  this  suspension  of  action 
must  not  be  laid  to  the  civil  power,  as  is 
sometimes  done,  but  to  the  Metropolitans, 
bishops  and  clergy  themselves  ;  for  by  the 
Eoyal  writs  always  issued  acourse  with  the 
writs  for  Parliament,  the  Convocations  were 
uninterruptedly  placed  in  a  condition  to 
proceed  to  business  without  let  or  hin- 
drance, so  far  as  civil  authority  was  con- 
cerned. 


CONVOCATIONS 

Before  the  year  1664  it  was  impossible 
that  they  should  so  separate  without  pro- 
ceeding to  active  work,  because  until  that 
year  they  taxed  themselves  in  their  Convo- 
cations and  were  not  generally  amenable  to 
parliamentary  taxation.  In  Saxon  times 
the  lands  of  all  clergy  were  held  by  frank- 
almoigne ;  that  is,  were  free  from  all  other 
taxation  except  for  the  support  of  castles, 
bridges,  and  expeditions.  IJut  William  the 
Conqueror  turned  the  frankalmoigne  tenures- 
of  the  bishops  into  baronies  which  became 
thenceforward,  subject  to  escuage,  a  money 
payment  in  lieu  of  supplying  soldiers.  But 
the  lower  clergy  not  possessing  baronies  stilL 
held  their  lands  in  frankalmoigne,  and  were- 
in  a  great  measure  exempt  from  the  charges 
which  fell  on  other  subjects.  It  was  con- 
sequently deemed  right  that  they  should 
contribute  more  equitably  to  the  public 
burdens ;  and  after  several  methods  for  this-' 
purpose  had  been  tried,  the  practice  at  last 
obtained  that  they  should  tax  themselves  in 
their  Convocations  and  there  vote  "sub- 
sidies" or  "benevolences"  to  the  Crown. 
This  practice  continued  as  above  said  to  the- 
year  1664,  when  by  a  private  agreement 
between  Archbishop  Sheldon,  the  Lord 
Chancellor  Clarendon,  and  some  other  of 
King  Charles  II.'s  ministers,  it  was  con- 
cluded that  the  clergy  should  waive  the 
privilege  of  taxing  their  own  body,  and 
should  permit  themselves  to  be  included  in 
the  money  bills  prepared  by  the  House  of 
Commons.  So  great  a  constitutional  change 
has  perhaps  never  before  or  since  been 
effected  by  a  private  arrangement.  Jeremy 
Collier  prophesied  that  after  the  clergy- 
ceased  to  tax  themselves  their  opinions  and 
interests  would  be  more  slenderly  regarded ; 
and  he  seems  to  have  been,  from  subsequent- 
experiences,  no  false  prophet. 

Bevival  of  Convocational  Action.  — After- 
the  admission  of  Jews  and  other  aliens  from 
the  Church's  faith  into  Parliament  a  feeling- 
began  to  prevail  among  Churchmen,  and 
indeed  among  all  reasonable  people,  and 
rapidly  spread,  that  that  assembly  was  not 
a  fitting  or  convenient  arena  for  the  dis-' 
cussion  at  least  of  spiritual  matters  affecting- 
the  Church.  It  was  thought  that  th  e  Ch-urch 
should  herself  speak  on  such  matters,  and 
that  her  voice  could  only  be  rightly  heard 
through  her  Provincial  Synods  or  Convoca- 
tions. Consequently  as  the  first  half  of  this 
century  approached  completion  strenuous, 
efforts  were  made  for  the  revival  of  their 
active  functions.  Among  the  most  active 
promoters  of  this  object  were,  the  late 
Samuel  WUberforce,  then  Bishop  of  Oxford,, 
and  the  late  Mr.  Henry  Hoare.  Although 
our  two  Metropolitans  at  that  time.  Dr. 
Sumner  and  Dr.  Musgrave,  were  not  favour-, 
able  to  the  movement,  still  the  general  feel- 


CONVOCATIONS 

ing  in  the  Cliureli  finally  prevailed,  and 
from  the  year  1852  Convocations  have  re- 
sumed their  active  and  proper  functions. 
They  now  meet  acourse  with  every  session 
of  Parliament,  and  usually  each  holds  two  or 
three  groups  of  sessions  in  every  year  during 
the  parliamentary  session. 

The  most  prominent  acts  of  the  Convo- 
cations since  the  revival  of  their  active 
functions  have  been — the  revision  and 
re-enactment  of  the  Canons  touching  clergy 
subscription ;  the  revision  of  the  lectionary 
in  the  Prayer  Book;  the  provision  for 
shortened  services  (and  it  is  encouraging  to 
observe  that  the  Act  of  Parliament  for  this 
purpose,  35  &  36  Vict.  c.  35,  amending  the 
Act  of  Uniformity,  recites  according  to 
ancient  and  time-honoured  practice,  a  refer- 
ence to  the  Convocations  in  its  preamble); 
the  synodical  condemnation  of  Dr.  Coleuso's 
writings  and  of  the  book  entitled  "  Essays 
and  Reviews ; "  the  five  decrees  synod  i- 
cally  ratified  touching  the  Vatican  Council 
in  1870;  and  the  promulgation  of  a  har- 
vest service.  Numerous  reports  also  of 
the  highest  interest  on  clergy  discipline 
and  other  cognate  subjects  have  been  issued, 
recommending  measures  which,  if  canoni- 
cally  enacted,  would  prove  of  incalculable 
benefit  to  the  Church. 

Moreover  at  this  time  (1885)  the  upper 
house  of  Canterbury  is  engaged  in  providing 
"  a  Manual  of  Family  Prayer,"  and  the 
lower  house  "Manuals  of  Private  Prayer," 
for  members  of  the  Church  of  England. 
And  it  is  to  be  hoped  that  in  due  time  they 
will  provide  other  Offices  emphatically 
needed  in  this  Church.  Such  are  Offices  for 
the  consecration  of  churches  and  cemeteries ; 
for  the  reception  of  renegades ;  for  the 
confirmation  of  those  who  have  been 
baptized  as  adults;  for  the  dedication  of 
bells ;  for  the  appointment  of  lay  deacons 
and  deaconesses,  and  for  other  like  purposes. 
Such  additions  to  our  authorized  formularies 
are  much  needed,  and  to  supply  them 
would  be  but  to  imitate  the  example  of  the 
Eastern  Church  (the  mother  of  this  Church), 
which  supplies  offices  in  her  "  Euchologion  " 
for  the  manifold  contingencies  of  the  Chris- 
tian life. 

CoNCLTTSiON. — In  conclusion  it  is  worthy 
of  remark  that  the  constitution  of  our 
Convocations  or  Provincial  Synods,  con- 
sisting of  bishops  and  presbyters,  without 
any  admixture  of  laymen  with  voices  de- 
cisive, is  in  accordance  with  the  principle 
which  has  governed  the  constitution  of 
Synods  in  all  ages  of  the  Church.  That 
principle  may  be  traced  back  even  to  Apo- 
stolic times.  The  first  Council  of  Jerusalem, 
recorded  in  the  15th  chapter  of  the  Acts, 
has  always  been  considered  in  the  orthodox 
Church  to  be  the  true  prototype  and  model 


CONVOCATIONS 


249- 


for  the  constitution  of  such  assemblies.  The 
history,  therefore,  of  that  Apostolic  Council 
is  of  the  liighest  possible  interest,  and  is 
closely  applicable  to  the  present  subject.  A 
question  had  arisen  in  the  Church  at 
Antioch  on  a  matter  of  disciplinary  ritual — 
whether  circumcision  were  necessary  or  not 
for  Christians.  For  the  settlement  of  doubts 
it  was  decided  that  S.  Paul  and  Barnabas, 
with  others,  should  go  up  to  Jerusalem  "  unto 
the  Apostles  and  Elders  "  about  this  question. 
"  27*6  Apostles  and  Elders  "  only  assembled 
to  consider  of  the  matter.  After  discussion, 
S.  James,  Bishop  of  Jerusalem,  and  so  chief 
of  the  assembly,  delivered  judgment.  Mes- 
sengers were  then  despatched  from  the 
whole  Church  of  Jerusalem  to  Antioch, 
bearing  letters  thither  containing  the  results 
of  the  deliberations.  The  superscription  of 
the  letters  was  that  of  "  the  Apostles  and 
Elders  "  only,  for  it  is  to  be  observed  that  the 
word  "  and  "  before  the  word  "  Brethren  " 
attached  to  the  superscription  in  our  Author- 
ized Version  is  not  warranted  by  the  best 
MSS.  All  such  give  the  superscription  thus, 
"The  ajMstles  and  elders— brethren  send 
greeting,"  &c.  And  it  is  further  observable 
that  when  S.  Paul  and  Silas  subsequently 
journeyed  through  the  cities,  they  delivered 
them  "the  decrees  for  to  keep  that  were 
ordained  by '  the  Apostles  and  Elders '  which 
were  at  Jerusalem."  Thus  we  see  that  in 
this  Apostolic  Council  the  question  under 
discussion  was  submitted  to  the  Apostles 
and  Elders  only,  that  they  only  came  to- 
gether to  consider  the  matter,  tliat  they  only 
signed  the  Encyclical  Letter,  and  that  to- 
them  only  the  decrees  of  the  Council  are- 
subsequently  attributed. 

As  the  Apostolic  band  was  chosen  by  the- 
Lord  to  constitute  the  first  order  of  the 
ministry  in  His  Church,  so  the  second  order 
of  Presbyters  or  Elders  was  inaugurated  when 
the  Lord  "  appointed  seventy  other  also,  and 
sent  them  two  and  two  before  His  face  into- 
every  city  and  place  whither  He  Himself 
would  come."  Of  these  two  orders  the  first 
ApostoUc  Council  of  Jerusalem  was  composed; 
and  in  conformity  with  the  example  of  that 
model  Council,  and  deeming  it  the  true- 
prototype  for  all  subsequent  Synods,  Church 
Councils  have  in  all  ages  been  convened  con- 
sisting of  the  first  and  second  Orders  of  the 
Ministry  of  Christ — Bishops  and  Presbyters- 
Such  is  the  constitution  of  the  two  Convo- 
cations or  Provincial  Synods  of  the  Bnglisb 
Church ;  and  contemplating  her  adherence  to 
Apostolic  precedent,  and  to  the  example  of 
the  first  Cotmcil  of  Jerusalem  in  this  respect, 
the  words  may  well  recur  to  memory — 
"  Her  foundations  are  upon  the  holy  hills." 
The  prophetic  exhortation  has  been  faith- 
fully obeyed  by  this  Church  of  England — 
"  Stand  ye  in  the  ways,  and  see,  and  ask 


■250 


CONVOCATIONS 


for  the  old  paths,  where  is  the  good  way,  and 
walk  therein."    [J.  W.  J.] 

CONVOCATIONS,  POWER  OF.  The 
Convocations  since  their  revival  in  1852,  after 
a  sleep  of  135  years,  have  only  once  had  "  let- 
ters of  business  "  for  the  purpose  of  making 
a  new  canon  on  a  matter  not  already  the 
subject  of  a  BUI  in  Parliament,  viz.  to  repeal 
the  prohibition  of  fathers  being  godfathers 
to  their  children  in  Canon  29;  but  after 
all  it  never  received  the  Royal  ratification 
afterwards,  which  is  also  necessary  to  make 
a  vahd  canon.  Their  adoption  of  the  passing 
Bill  for  altering  clerical  subscription  under 
the  36th  Canon  has  been  already  noticed 
(see  Canons),  and  is  evidently  a  different 
matter  from  independent  legislation,  as  it 
made  no  difference  whether  the  Convocations 
followed  Parliament  or  not.  The  appoint- 
ment by  one  Convocation  of  two  committees 
in  1872  to  revise  the  Authorized  Version  of 
the  0.  and  N.  T.  was  not  canon-making,  and 
neither  had  nor  needed  any  Royal  authority, 
nor  had  any  in  itself.  In  1864  the  Southern 
Convocation  passed  a  resolution  in  both 
Houses  that  they  "  synodicaUy  condemned 
the  volume  entitled  Essays  and  Reviews^^ 
under  very  high  legal  advice  that  they  had 
still  the  right  to  do  so,  though  not  to  fake 
any  other  proceedings  against  the  authors. 
In  1872  they  did  something  more  important, 
under  "  letters  of  business,"  in  preparing  the 
shortened  services  afterwards  authorized  by 
Act  35  &  36  Vict.  c.  35 ;  and  their  having 
done  so  is  recited  in  the  Act,  as  their  approval 
of  the  Prayer  Book  of  1662  is  recited  in  the 
Act  of  Uniformity,  14  Car.  II.  c.  4.  The  Praj-er 
Book  of  1  Eliz.  c.  2  was  not  submitted  to 
the  Convocations,  for  the  very  good  reason 
that  the  great  majority  of  the  bishops  and 
clergy  were  still  Papists,  as  stated  by  Bishop 
Stubbs  in  the  report  of  the  Commission  on 
Ecclesiastical  Courts  of  1883.  But  it  con- 
tained very  slight  alterations  on  the  Second 
P.  B.  of  Edward  VI. 

It  is  quite  clear,  however,  that  no  Act. 
about  ecclesiastical  judicature  was  ever  sub- 
mitted to  the  Convocations.  The  distinction 
between  that  and  the  making  of  canons  and 
alterations  in  the  Services  and  Articles  of  the 
•Church,  with  the  sanction  of  the  Crown  and 
Parliament,  is  decisively  exhibited  by  the 
primary  Acts  of  the  Reformation,  24  Hen. 
VIII.  c.  12,  for  ecclesiastical  appeals,  and  "  for 
the  submission  of  the  clergy,"  25  Hen.  VIII. 
•c.  19,  of  which  one-half  enacted  the  submission 
made  previously  by  the  Convocations  (pro- 
mising to  attempt  to  make  no  more  canons 
without  royal  licence),  and  again  the  other 
half  of  the  Act  established  a  new  court  of 
ecclesiastical  appeal  to  unlimited  "delegates," 
who  were  limited  to  the  Judicial  Committee 
of  the  Privy  Council  just  three  centuries  after. 
'That  part  of  the  Act  was  never  submitted  to 


COPE 

the  Convocations,  nor  did  they  attempt  to 
meddle  with  it.  Neither  were  they  consulted 
when  the  delegates  were  limited  to  the  Judicial 
Committee  of  the  Privj'  CouncU  in  1832-3. 
Indeed  the  Convocations  were  not  then  al- 
lowed even  to  sit.  The  attempt  to  give 
them  any  kind  of  control  over  jurisdiction  is 
absolutely  modern  and  unjustified  by  a 
shigle  precedent. 

In  Philhmore's  Ecc.  Law,  p.  1949  et  seq.,  is 
a  valuable  report  of  a  committee  of  the  Lower 
House  of  Canterbury  in  1854,  soon  after  its 
revival,  under  the  presidency  of  a  most  able 
Prolocutor,  Dean  Peacock,  which  concluded 
that  the  Lower  House  has  no  right  to  decide 
on  disputed  elections.  To  which  it  may  be 
added,  that  the  Courts  of  Law  have  decided 
that  all  the  canons  or  prebendaries  of  an 
"  old  "  cathedral  have  the  right  to  vote ;  but 
no  other  case  has  occurred  of  an  election  of 
proctors  being  tried  there.  That  and  other 
books  specially  on  this  subject,  such  as  Loth- 
bury's,  must  be  consulted  as  to  the  procedure 
and  rules  of  Convocation.  It  seems  to  be  ad- 
mitted that  the  President  of  each  Convoca- 
tion, i.e.  the  Archbishop  while  there  is  one, 
has  a  final  veto,  besides  a  casting  vote  if  they 
are  equal. 

Various  great  legal  officials,  both  of  the 
Crown  and  Archbishops  of  Canterbury,  have 
given  opinions  that  the  Convocations  have  no 
power  to  alter  their  own  constitution,  and  that 
the  Crown  can  authorize  no  canons  for  that 
purpose.  In  that  state  of  things,  it  is  quite 
certain  that  the  Crowii  will  not  profess  to 
authorize  them,  and  it  is  useless  to  go  further 
into  the  question.  It  is  a  different  one  how 
far  the  two  primates  have  power  to  adapt 
the  elections  of  proctors  to  the  circumstances 
of  new  dioceses,  as  they  have  done  without 
objection;  and  that  is  not  altering  the  con- 
stitution, which  there  is  no  evidence  that 
any  convocation  has  ever  attempted  to  do, 
either  by  canons  or  otherwise.  The  only- 
power  that  can  do  it  now  is  Parliament, 
which  Umited  the  power  of  the  convocation 
by  the  Act  of  Submission.     [H.] 

COPE.  {Cappa,  called  also  pallium,  or 
pluviale.)  A  kind  of  cloak  worn  during 
Divine  service  by  the  clergj'.  It  reaches 
from  the  neck  nearly  to  the  feet,  and  is 
open  in  front,  except  at  the  top,  where  it 
is  united  by  a  band  or  clasp.  It  is  in  use 
in  the  Western  Church  only;  and  is  pro- 
bably only  a  modification  of  the  vestment, 
or  chasuble.  The  latter,  in  the  Roman 
Church,  is  used  bj'  the  officiating  priest  at 
mass  only ;  the  other,  by  all  orders  of  tlie 
clergy  in  procession,  &c.,  on  solemn  occa- 
sions. The  rubrics  of  King  Edward  VI., 
considered  by  some  to  be  still  legally  in 
force,  prescribe  a  cope  or  vestment  for  the 
priest  administering  the  Holy  Communion, 
and  for  tbe  bishops,  when   executing  any 


COPIATiE 

public  ministration  in  tlie  cliuich;  for 
whicli  a  vestment  may  be  substituted  either 
by  priest  or  bishop.  By  the  24th  Canon  of 
1603  the  cope  only  is  prescribed  to  the 
priest  administering  the  Communion,  and 
that  only  in  cathedral  churches.  But  the 
rubric  being  subsequently  enacted  in  1662, 
which  refers  to  the  regulation  of  Edward 
VI.'s  First  Piuyer  Book,  the  latter  is  by 
m.any  considered  to  be  more  strictly  the  law 
of  the  Church.  The  Privy  Council  however 
has  twice  decided  otherwise.  It  was  used  in 
several  churches  and  college  chapels  in  the 
seventeenth  century,  and  was  in  use  at 
Durham  cathedral  and  Westminster  till  the 
middle  of  the  last  century.  De  Foe,  in  his 
anonymous  Tour  through  England,  1762, 
says  that  "  the  old  vestments,  which  the 
clergy  before  the  Reformation  wore,  are  still 
used  on  Sundays  and  holidays,  by  the 
residents." 

The  assertion  made  by  Dean  Sampson 
and  Humphries  in  Queen  Elizabeth's  reign, 
"  that  copes  were  brought  in  by  the  Papists," 
was  ably  refuted  by  Archbishop  Parker. — 
Jebb,  Choral  Service,  p.  217 ;  Strype's 
Parker,  158. 

COPIAT^.  The  oflce  of  the  Copiatas 
(KOTTtau,  to  labour),  who  are  called  in  Latin 
Fossarii,  and  in  Justinian's  novels  hcticarii, 
was  to  superintend  funerals,  and  to  see  that 
all  persons  had  a  decent  burial.  They  per- 
formed their  oflice  gratuitously  towards  the 
poor. — Bingham,  bk.  iii.  8. 

COPTS,  or  COPTIC  CHURCH.  The 
Monophysite,  or  Jacobite,  Christians  of 
Egypt,  who  have  been  for  many  centuries 
in  possession  of  the  patriarchal  chair  of 
Alexandria,  and  the  dominant  sect  among 
the  Christians  of  that  region,  are  called 
Copts,  probably  from  Goptos,  a  city  in  Upper 
Egypt ;  but  other  derivations  are  given. 
Their  existence  as  a  separate  or  heretical 
Church  dat-es  from  the  time  of  the  Council 
of  Chalcedon.  (See  Chcdcedon,  Councils  of.) 
The  banishment  of  Dioscurus,  patriarch  of 
Alexandria,  by  that  council,  fully  deserved 
as  it  was,  was  the  origin  of  the  schism  in 
the  Church  of  Alexandria.  Proterius  was 
elected  in  Dioscurus'  place,  and  it  was  hoped 
that  the  Monophysite  heresy  would  die 
out.  But  it  did  not.  The  followers  of 
Dioscurus,  after  his  death,  elected  Timothy 
jElurus,  who  being  active  (he  was  nick- 
named "the  cat")  and  very  vehement 
sained  a  great  following.  Proterius  was 
barbarously  murdered;  Timothy,  on  the 
other  hand,  was  banished,  but  afterwards 
recalled.  The  Catholics  and  the  Copts,  or 
Jacobites,  from  that  time  had  each  their 
leader;  trouble  after  trouble  ensued;  and 
though  many  attempts  were  made  for  peace, 
the  rupture  was  never  healed.  When  the 
wave  of  Mohammedanism  swept  along,  and 


CORONATION 


251 


Alexandria  was  taken  by  Amer,  the  general 
sent  by  the  Caliph  Omar,  the  Copts  received 
the  supiMrt  of  the  Mohammedan  as  against 
the  Catholics,  and  were  placed  in  possession 
of  the  Egyptian  churches. 

Their  numbers  are  now  perhaps  about 
150,000.  They  have  three  liturgies, — that 
ascribed  to  St.  Basil,  which  they  use  on 
ordinary  fast  days ;  that  of  St.  Cyril,  which 
they  use  in  Lent ;  and  that  of  St.  Gregory, 
which  they  use  on  festivals.  Their  service  is 
very  much  crowded  with  ceremonies.  The 
Coptic  tongue,  in  which  their  worship  is  con- 
ducted, is  to  them  a  dead  language,  and  not 
even  understood  by  many  of  their  priests. 
Their  habits  of  life  are  ascetic,  and  they 
have  many  monasteries.  They  have  a 
patriarch,  who  resides  at  Cairo,  but  takes 
his  title  from  Alexandria.  (Neale's  Hist. 
Patriarch.)  A  full  account  of  the  Coptic 
Church  to  the  present  time  is  to  be  found 
in  Smith  and  Wace,  Did.  of  Biog.,  &c.,  665 
seq.,  and  in  a  work  by  Mr.  Butler,  a  fellow 
of  Brasenose,  Oxford  (Clarendon  Press,  a.d. 
1885). 

CORBEL.  A  bracket.  A  projection 
supporting  a  weight;  and  so  corbel-table, 
a  table  or  horizontal  projection  supported 
by  corbels.  Corbel-tables  are  almost  con- 
fined to  the  Norman,  Transition,  and  Early 
English  periods.  Corbels  in  other  places 
are  of  course  continued ;  they  are  often 
beautifully  decorated  with  head!s,  angels,  or 
foliage,  and  sometimes  grotesque.     [Gr.] 

CORDELIERS.  {Monks  of  tlie  Order 
of  St.  Francis.)  They  wear  coarse  grey 
cloth  with  a  little  cowl,  and  a  rope  girdle 
with  three  knots;  from  this  girdle  they 
are  called  Cordeliers.  They  are  the  same 
with  the  Minorites ;  but  had  the  name  of 
Cordeliers  given  them  upon  a  certain  occa- 
sion, when,  having  repulsed  the  infidels  in 
a  war  which  St.  Louis  made  against  them, 
the  king  asked  their  name,  and  was 
answered,  they  were  des  Gens  des  Cordeliers 
— people  with  cords  about  them.  (See 
Franciscans.) 

CORONATION  AND  CONSECRA- 
TION OP  SOVEREIGNS.  The  solemn 
religious  rite  by  which  a  sovereign  prince 
is  consecrated  to  his  high  office,  in  which 
also  the  queen  consort  in  Christian  countries 
is  usually  associated  with  her  husband,  not 
for  office'  sake,  but  honoris  gratia. 

Consecration  with  unction. — This  reaches 
to  a  greater  antiquity  than  the  Christian 
era.  We  have  but  to  refer  to  the  history 
of  the  Old  Testament  to  see  that  it  was 
divinely  ordered  and  sanctioned.  St.  Au- 
gustine speaks  of  the  rite  of  consecration 
as  peculiar  to  God's  people,  and  not  ever 
adopted  by  the  heathens.  But  who  was 
the  first  Christian  prince  consecrated  and 
crowned  by  the  bishops  of  the  Church  is 


252 


COBONATION 


not  known.  Theodosius  the  Younger  is 
supposed  to  have  been  the  first  who  was 
crowned  by  the  Patriarch  of  Constantmople, 
and  there  is  httle  doubt  as  to  the  consecra- 
tion of  the  Emperor  Justm  (519).  But 
before  this  there  was  the  famous  tradition 
of  the  coronation  and  anomting  of  Chlod- 
wig  or  Clovis,  the  oil  being  miraculously 
supplied  from  heaven.  Hincmar,  Arch- 
bishop of  Eheims  in  the  ninth  century, 
also  claimed  for  the  holy  oil  that  it  had 
been  miraculously  afforded.  But  this  was 
probably  asserted  in  order  to  prove  that  the 
Frank  sovereigns  had  a  precedence  over 
others.  In  our  country  there  seems  to  be 
sufficient  evidence  that  the  rite  of  anointing 
at  coronations  can  be  traced,  with  certainty, 
higher  than  in  any  other.  Pepm  was  the 
first  king  of  the  Franks  who  was  anointed. 
(Martene,  de  Ant.  Ecc.  Bit.  tom.ii.  -p.  213.) 
But  before  the  coronation  of  Pepin,  the 
pontifical  of  Archbishop  Egbert  (a.d.  737) 
ordered  the  rite  of  unction  at  a  coronation. 
And  long  before  this,  in  the  earlier  British 
Church,  there  is  the  testimony  in  Gildas, 
"  unguebantur  reges,  et  non  per  Deum,  sed 
qui  caiteris  crudeliores  exstavent :  et  paulo 
post  ab  unctoribus,  non  pro  veri  examinati- 
ons, trucidabantur,  aliis  electis  trucioribus." 
{Hist.  sec.  21.)  For  the  consecration  in  such 
a  solemn  manner  we  have  evidence  in  the 
Saxon  Chronicle,  follo^ving  a  more  ancient 
writer.  "  Egberth,"  it  is  said,  "  was  haUowed 
to  king  " — "  rex  est  consecratus."  (Stubbs' 
Councils,  vol.  iii.  p.  444.) 

From  those  early  times  to  the  present, 
great  solemnity  has  been  observed  with 
regard  to  the  consecration  and  coronation  of 
sovereigns.  As  the  consecration  of  chrism 
has  been  discontinued  since  the  Eeformation, 
the  account  of  this  part  of  James  the 
Second's  coronation  may  be  interesting. 
Early  in  the  morning  the  Dean  of  West- 
minster, with  the  assistance  of  the  pre- 
bendaries, consecrated  the  holy  oil  for  their 
majesties'  anointing.  The  dean  happened 
to  be  a  bishop  (the  Bishop  of  Rochester), 
and  it  may  be  supposed  that  at  other  times 
the  archbishop  himself,  or  some  other 
bishop,  would  consecrate  the  oil.  (Maskell, 
Mon.  Bit.  ii.,  iii.)  We  have  still  the  forms 
used  in  the  ancient  times,  from  which  our 
Coronation  Service  (slightly  modified  from 
time  to  time)  is  substantially  derived.  (See 
Dr.  Silver's  Coronation  Service,  or  Consecra- 
tion of  the  Anglo-Saxon  Kings.) 

It  is  a  form  of  immemorial  prescription, 
substantially  the  same  as  that  used  at  the 
inauguration  of  our  Christian  monarchs  in 
Saxon  times,  and  sanctioned  by  the  solemn 
approval  of  all  the  estates  of  the  realm, 
the  nobility,  the  clergy,  and  the  people, 
assembled  at  its  celebration.  The  prayers 
are  framed  in  the  best  spirit  of  antiquity. 


COENET 

with  tlie  rhythm  so  characteristic  of  primi- 
tive forms,  and  with  an  elevation  and 
majesty  of, sentiment  unsurpassed  in  any 
part  of  our  liturgy.  The  service  is,  however, 
peculiarly  valuable,  as  recording  certain 
high  religious  and  political  principles,  which 
of  course  must  be  considered  as  receiving 
the  full  sanction  of  the  Church  and  nation. 
Thus  there  is  an  acknowledgment  of  the 
sovereignty  of  Christ  over  the  whole  world, 
and  the  derivation  of  all  kingly  power  from 
Him.  "  When  you  see  this  orb  set  under 
the  cross,  remember  that  the  whole  world  is 
subject  to  the  power  and  empire  of  Christ 
our  Eedeemer.  For  He  is  the  Prince  of  the 
kings  of  the  earth,  King  of  kings,  and  Lord 
of  lords ;  so  that  no  man  can  reign  happily, 
who  derives  not  his  authority  from  Hkn, 
and  directs  not  all  his  actions  according  to 
His  laws."  It  is  declared  that  Christian 
sovereigns,  like  the  Jewish  kings  of  old,  are 
consecrated  to  the  fulness  of  their  ofiice  by 
the  religious  right  of  unction,  and  that 
their  function  is  not  merely  secular.  "  Bless 
and  sanctify  Thy  chosen  servant  Victoria, 
who  by  our  office  and  ministry  is  now  to  be- 
anomted  with  this  oil,  and  consecrated 
Queen  of  this  realm."  There  is  a  strict 
recognition  of  the  prerogative  of  the  clergy, 
empowered,  as  the  ministers  of  Christ,  to 
assert  the  dominion  of  our  Lord,  who  exalts 
her  to  her  holy  dignity  :  "  Stand  firm  and 
hold  fast  from  henceforth  the  seat  and  the 
state  of  royal  and  imperial  dignity,  which  is. 
this  day  delivered  to  you  m  the  name  and 
by  the  authority  of  Almighty  God,  and  by 
the  hands  of  us,  the  bishops  and  servants 
of  God,  though  unworthy :  and  as  you  see 
us  to  approach  nearer  to  God's  altar,  so 
vouchsafe  the  more  graciously  to  continue 
to  us  your  royal  favour  and  protection. 
And  the  Lord  God  Almighty,  whose 
ministers  we  are,  and  the  stewards  of  His 
mysteries,  establish  you  therein  in  righteous- 
ness, that  it  may  stand  fast  for  evermore." — 
Palmer. 

By  ancient  custom,  the  coronation  of  the 
Sovereign  of  England  belongs  to  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  and  that  of  the  queen 
consort  to  the  Archbishop  of  York.  The 
place  is  Westminster  Abbey,  and  under  the 
coronation  chair  is  the  sacred  stone  upon 
which  the  kings  of  Scotland  were  cro^vned  at 
Scone,  whence  it  was  brought  by  Edward  L 
(For  Coronation  Services,  see  Maskell,  Mon. 
Bit.  ii.  1,  and  Coronation  Service  according 
to  the  use  of  the  Church  of  England,  edited 
by  J.  F.  Eussell,  B.C.L.,  Pickermg,  1875.) 
[H.] 

COENET.  A  species  of  horn  or  trumpet 
formerly  much  used  in  the  Church  service, 
in  the  king's  chapel  especially.  Dr.  Eim- 
bault,  in  his  Notes  on  Boger  North's  Memoirs 
of  Music,  states,  that  in  the  statutes  of 


COEPOEAL 

•Canterbury  cathedral  provision  is  made  for 
players  on  sackbuts  and  cornets  on  high 
festivals.  After  the  Restoration,  as  appears 
from  North's  Life  of  Guildford,  the  cornet 
was  used  at  Durham  and  York  cathedrals ; 
and  Matthew  Lock  says,  that  for  about  a 
year  after  the  opening  of  the  Eoyal  Chapel, 
the  cornet  was  used  to  supply  the  want  of 
treble  voices. 

Evelyn,  in  his  Memoirs  (21  Dec,  1663), 
complains  of  violins  being  substituted  in 
,the  Royal  Chapel  "  instead  of  the  ancient, 
grave,  and  solemn  wind-music  accompanying 
the  organ ;  "  and  that  "  we  no  more  heard 
the  cornet,  which  gave  life  to  the  organ,  that 
instrument  being  quite  left  off,  in  which  the 
English  were  so  skilful." 

CORPORAL.  This  is  the  name  given  to 
the  linen  cloth  on  which  the  elements  are 
consecrated  in  the  Holy  Communion.  In 
the  Eastern  Church  it  is  called  the  veil.  It 
is  mentioned  in  the  Liturgy  of  St.  Chry- 
sostom,  and  in  the  Sacramentary  of  St. 
Gregory  there  is  a  prayer  for  its  benediction. 
It  was  of  common  use  in  the  Church  in  the 
fifth  century,  as  is  evident  from  the  testimony 
of  Isidore  of  Pelusium,  who  observes  that 
the  design  of  using  it  was  to  represent  the 
body  of  our  Saviour  being  wrapped  in  fine 
linen  by  Joseph  of  Arimathea;  and  in  a 
jirayer  for  blessing  the  corporal,  the  words 
.occur,  "  sicut  m  sindone  linea  et  munda 
sepultam  cognovimus  camem  D.  nostri  I. 
Ohristi,  qui  tecum  vivit."  (Martene,  de  Bit. 
torn.  ii.  248.)     [H.] 

The  direction  concerning  this  "  fair  Imen 
cloth  "  in  our  Order  of  the  Holy  Communion 
is  as  follows  :  "  When  all  have  communi- 
loated,  the  minister  shall  return  to  the  Lord's 
table,  and  reverently  place  upon  it  what 
remaineth  of  the  consecrated  elements, 
covering  the  same  with  a  fair  linen  cloth." 

CORPO 11 ATION  ACT.  A  statute  passed 
by  the  First  Parliament  of  Charles  II.,  1661, 
which  enacted  that  all  officers  of  corpora- 
tions should  receive  the  Sacrament  of  Holy 
Communion,  aocordiiag  to  the  rites  of  the 
Church  of  England,  -within  twelve  months  of 
their  appointment,  on  their  election  should 
take  the  oaths  of  supremacy,  allegiance, 
and  non-resistance,  and  abjure  the  Solemn 
League  and  Covenant.  The  Act  was  re- 
pealed in  1828,  having  long  become  a  dead 
letter. 

CORPUS  CHRISTI,  FEAST  OF.  A 
Koman  festival,  instituted  by  Pope  Urban 
IV.,  A.D.  1264,  and  observed  on  the  Thurs- 
day of  the  week  after  Pentecost.  The  insti- 
tution was  the  natural  result  of  the  accep- 
tance of  the  doctrine  of  transubstantiation. 
The  festival  was  established  in  honom-  of 
the  consecrated  host,  and  with  a  view  to  its 
jid oration.     (See  Transubstantiation.) 

CORRODY.    The  right  of  a  founder  or 


COUNCILS 


253 


benefactor  of  a  monastery  to  board  and 
lodging  for  himself  or  his  family  within  the 
religious  house.  Other  privileges  were  also 
sometimes  included  under  this  name,  as 
the  education  of  the  benefactor's  sons,  and 
the  training  of  some  of  his  servants. 

CORSNED.     (See  Ordeal.) 

COUNCILS.  (See  Synod.)  General  or 
oecumenical  councils,  or  synods,  are  assem- 
blies of  bishops  from  all  parts  of  the  Church, 
to  determine  some  weighty  controversies  of 
faith  or  discipline.  Of  such  councils  the 
Catholic  or  Universal  Church  has  never 
received  or  approved  more  than  six,  although 
the  Roman  Church  acknowledges  several 
others.  The  first  Catholic  Council  is  that  of 
Nicsea,  which  was  convened  by  the  Emperor 
Constantine,  a.d.  325,  to  terminate  the 
controversy  raised  by  Arius,  presbyter  of 
Alexandria,  who  denied  the  divinity  of  the 
Son  of  God,  maintaining  that  he  was  a 
creature  brought  forth  from  nothing,  and 
susceptible  of  vice  and  virtue.  1'he  Council 
condemned  his  doctrine  as  heretical,  and 
declared  the  faith  of  the  Church  in  that 
celebrated  creed  called  the  Nicene  Creed, 
which  is  repeated  by  us  in  the  Communion 
Service,  and  which  has,  ever  since  its  pro- 
mulgation, been  received  and  venerated  by 
the  Universal  Church,  and  even  by  many 
sects  and  heretics.  (See  Nice.)  The  second 
general  council  was  that  of  Constantinople, 
assembled  by  the  Emperor  Theodosius  the 
Elder,  in  381,  to  appease  the  troubles  of  the 
East.  (See  Constantinople.)  The  thud 
general  council  was  assembled  at  Ephesus, 
A.D.  431,  by  the  Emperor  Theodosius  the 
Yomiger,  to  determine  the  controversy 
raised  by  Nestorius,  bishop  of  Constanti- 
nople. By  this  council  the  Nestorian 
heretics  were  condemned.  (See  Ephesus.) 
The  fourth  general  council  was  assembled  by 
the  Emperor  Marcian,  in  451,  at  Chalcedon. 
(See  Chalcedon,  Council  of.)  The  fifth  and 
sixth  general  councils  were  held  at  Constan- 
tinople in  553  and  680.  "  These  are  the 
only  councils,"  says  Mr.  Palmer,  "which 
the  Universal  Church  has  ever  received  and 
approved  as  general."  The  doctrine  of  these 
general  councils,  having  been  approved  and 
acted  on  by  the  whole  body  of  the  Catholic 
Church,  and  thus  ratified  by  an  universal 
consent,  which  has  continued  ever  since,  is 
irrefragably  true,  unalterable,  and  irreform- 
able ;  nor  could  any  Church  forsake  or 
change  the  doctrine  without  ceasing  to  be 
Christian. 

In  the  Act  of  the  1st  of  Elizabeth  .... 
the  commissioners,  in  their  judgment  of 
heresies,  were  enjoined  to  adhere,  in  the  first 
place,  to  the  authority  of  the  canonical 
Scriptures ;  secondly,  to  the  decisions  of  the 
first  four  general  councils;  and  thirdly,  to 
the  decision  of  any  other  general  council. 


254 


COUNSEL 


founded  on  the  express  and  j)?atji  words  of 
Holy  Scripture.  In  this  Act,  one  particular 
deserves  and  demands  very  sjiecial  attention  ; 
namely,  the  unqualified  deference  paid  to 
the  first  four  general  councils.  The  latest 
of  these  councUs  sat  and  deliberated  in  the 
year  451.  A  point  of  time,  therefore,  is 
fixed,  previously  to  which  the  Church 
of  England  imreservedly  recognises  the 
guidance  of  the  Catholic  Church,  in  the 
interpretation  of  Christian  verities. — Bishop 
Jehb,  Appendix  to  Practical  Sermons. 

Provincial  councils  consist  of  the  metro- 
politan and  the  bishops  subject  to  him. 
Diocesan  councils  are  assemblies  of  the 
bishop  and  his  jiresbyters  to  enforce  canons 
made  by  general  or  provincial  councils,  and 
to  consult  and  agree  upon  rules  of  discipline 
for  themselves.  (For  an  account  of  the 
Eomish  councils,  see  Lateran.  For  the 
authority  of  councils  in  the  Church  of 
England,  see  Heresy.) 

COUNSEL.  Besides  the  common  sig- 
nification of  the  word,  it  is  frequently  used 
in  Scripture  to  signify  the  designs  or  purposes 
of  God,  or  the  orders  of  His  providence. 
(Acts  iv.  28,  and  Psalm  Ixxiii.  24.)  It  also 
signifies  His  will  concerning  the  way  of 
salvation.    (St.  Luke  vii.  30;  Acts  xx.  27.) 

This  word  is  also  used  by  the  doctors  of 
the  Roman  Church  to  denote  those  precepts 
which  they  hold  to  be  binding  upon  the 
faithful,  in  virtue  of  an  implied  direction  or 
recommendation  of  our  Lord  and  His  apostles. 
Thus  the  celibacy  of  the  clergy  is  numbered 
by  them  among  "  evangelical  counsels," 
which,  receiving  the  acceptance  of  the 
Church,  they  hold,  heretically,  to  be  equally 
binding  with  the  commands  of  canonical 
Scripture. 

COURT  CHEISTIAN.  The  ecclesiasti- 
cal courts  are  so  designated.  In  the  Church 
of  England  there  are  six  spiritual  courts. 

1.  The  Archdeacon's  Court,  which  is  the 
lowest,  aud  is  held  in  places  where  the 
archdeacon,  either  by  prescription  or  compo- 
sition, has  jurisdiction  in  spiritual  or  ecclesi- 
astical causes  within  his  archdeaconry.  The 
judge  of  this  court  is  called  the  official  of  the 
archdeaconry. 

2.  The  Consistory  Courts  of  the  arch- 
bishops and  bishops  of  every  diocese,  held 
generally  in  their  cathedral  churches,  for 
trial  of  all  ecclesiastical  causes  within  the 
diocese.  The  bishop's  chancellor  is  the 
judge.  But  their  jurisdiction  was  very 
much  limited  by  the  Clergy  Discipline  Act, 
3  &  4  Yict. 

3.  The  Court  of  Audience,  which  origi- 
nated in  the  personal  jurisdiction  of  each 
primate. 

4.  The  Arches  Court  (so  called  because 
anciently  held  in  the  arched  church  of  St. 
Mary  (St.  Maria  de  Aroubus)  in  Cheapside, 


COUSINS-GERMAN 

London)  is  that  which  has  jurisdiction  upon 
appeal  in  all  ecclesiastical  causes.  'J'he 
judge  is  the  official  principal  of  both  the 
archbishops  by  the  Public  Worship  Act, 
1874. 

5.  The  Court  of  Peculiars,  of  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  subservient  to,  and  in 
connection  with,  that  of  the  Arches. 

The  Court  of  the  Province  of  York,  which 
corresponds  to  the  Comt  of  Arches,  and  now 
has  the  same  judge,  is  called  the  Chancery 
Court,  though  its  judge  is  not  the  chancellor, 
who  is  only  the  diocesan  judge  and  vicar- 
general  of  the  archbishop  for  the  province 
also. 

6.  The  Final  Appeal  Court,  from  both 
provinces,  is  the  Judicial  Committee  of  the 
Privy  Council,  which  was  .substituted  for 
the  Privy  Council  itself  in  1833,  which  was 
substituted  in  1832  for  the  unlimited 
delegates  appointed  by  the  Crown  for  each 
case,  who  had  existed  for  exactly  three 
centuries;  for  they  remained  concurrently 
with  the  Court  of  High  Commission  while  it 
lasted,  which  Queen  Elizabeth  was  author- 
ised to  estabhsh  by  the  first  Act  of  her 
reign,  with  the  powers  of  all  the  ecclesiasti- 
cal courts.  It  was  abolished  by  the  Bill  of 
Rights  or  the  Act  16  Car.  I.  c.  11,  which  was 
re-enacted  as  to  that  by  13  Car.  II.  c.  12.  It 
was  set  up  again  illegally  by  James  II.,  and 
again  abolished  or  declared  illegal  by  1  W. 
&  M.  sec.  2,  c.  2.  By  the  Clergy  Discipline 
Act,  1840,  the  bishops  who  are  members  of 
the  Privy  Council,  i.e.  the  archbishops  and 
the  Bishop  of  London,  were  added  to  the 
Judicial  Committee  for  appeals  under  that 
Act,  and  they  were  in  practice  summoned 
as  assessors  in  other  ecclesiastical  causes. 
In  1873  Bishop  Wilberforce  got  them 
removed  from  the  Judicial  Committee  by  a 
few  words  in  the  Judicature  Act;  but  in 
1876,  in  another  Judicature  Act,  all  the 
bishops  were  introduced  as  assessors  in 
rotation,  and  three  of  them  must  sit  even  on 
questions  of  legal  technicality  or  procedure, 
of  which  they  can  know  nothing  nor  be  of 
any  use.  It  is  unnecessary  to  speak  of  the 
report  of  the  Commission  of  1883  on  these 
courts  until  something  comes  of  it.     [G.] 

COUSINS-GERMAN.  Intermarriage  be- 
tween cousins-germanwas  not  prohibited  by 
the  Jewish  law,  nor  in  the  early  ages  of 
Christianity.  St.  Augustine  refers  to  such 
as  unadvisable,  but  not  illegal.  "With 
regard  to  marriage  between  cousins,"  he- 
says,  "we  have  observed  that  in  our  own 
time  the  customary  morality  has  prevented 
this  from  being  frequent,  thoughi  the  law 
allows  it.  It  was  not  prohibited  by  divine 
law,  nor  as  yet  had  human  law  prohibited 
it;  nevertheless,  though  legitimate,  people 
shrank  from  it,  because  it  lay  so  close  ta 
what  was   illegitimate,  and  in  marrying  a 


COVENANT 

cousin  seemed  almost  to  many  a  sister,  for 
cousins  are  so  closely  related  that  they  are 
called  brothers  and  sisters,  and  are  almost 
really  so."     {City  of  God,  xv.  16.) 

In  the  "  Trullan  "  Council,  marriage  with 
an  uncle's  daughter  was  forbidden;  and 
later  on,  marriages  of  relations  within  the 
fifth,  sixth,  and  even  seventh  degree  were 
prohibited.     (See  Affinity.)    [H.] 

COVENANT.  A  mutual  agreement 
between  two  or  more  parties.  (Gen.  xxi. 
32.)  In  the  Hebrew  the  word  signifies  : 
1.  A  disposition,  dispensation,  institution,  or 
appointment  of  God  to  man.  (Hebrews  ix. 
16,  17,  20.)  2.  The  religious  dispensation 
or  institution  which  God  ax^pointed  to 
Abi-aham  and  the  patriarchs.  (St.  Luke 
1.  72 ;  Acts  iii.  25,  vii.  8.)  3.  The  dispen- 
sation from  Sinai.  (Heb.  viii.  9 ;  Gal.  iv.  24.) 
4.  The  dispensation  of  faith  and  free  justi- 
fication, of  which  Christ  is  the  Mediator 
(Heb.  vii.  22 — viii.  6),  and  which  is  called 
new  in  respect  of  the  old  or  Sinai  covenant 
(2  Cor.  iii.  6  ;  Heb.  viii.  8,  13— ix.  15),  and 
whence  the  New  Covenant  or  Testament 
became  the  title  of  the  books  in  which  this 
new  dispensation  is  contained.  Into  this 
covenant  we  are  admitted  by  union  with 
Christ ;  and  into  imion  with  Christ  all 
infants,  and  such  adults  as  are  properly 
qualified  by  failh  and  repentance,  may  be 
admitted  in  holy  baptism.  (Gal.  iii.  27.) 
'5.  The  old  dispensation  is  used  for  the  books 
of  Moses  containing  that  dispensation  by  St. 
Paul.     (2  Cor.  iii.  14.) 

We  renew  our  baptismal  covenant  in  our 
confirmation,  and  in  each  faithful  participa- 
tion of  the  Eucharist. 

COVENANT  OF  REDEMPTION.  This 
is  said  to  be  the  mutual  stipulation  between 
the  everlasting  Father  and  the  co-eternal 
Son,  relating  to  the  salvation  of  our  fallen 
race,  previously  to  any  act  upon  the  part  of 
Christ  under  the  character  of  Mediator. 
That  there  was  such  a  covenant,  either  tacit 
or  express,  we  may  assuredly  conclude,  from 
the  importance  of  the  work  undertaken  by 
God  the  Son,  and  the  awful  sacrifice  made 
for  its  accomplishment.  All  the  prophecies 
which  relate  to  what  was  to  be  done  by  the 
Messiah  on  the  one  hand,  and  the  benefits 
and  rewards  which  were  to  be  conferred 
upon  Him  and  His  people  on  the  other,  may 
properly  be  considered  as  intimations  of  such 
a  covenant.  (1  St.  Pet.  i.  11.  Compare  St. 
John  xvii.  1-5, 14— vi.  37 ;  Tit.  i.  2 ;  2  Tim. 
i  9 ;  Rev.  xiii.  8 ;  Ps.  Ixxxix.  19.) 

COVENANT.  (See  League  and  Cove- 
nant.') 

COWL  (cuculla,  cucullus,  cucuIKo),  a  large 
hood  worn  by  monks,  prescribed  by  St. 
Benedict,  founder  of  the  order  which  bears 
his  name,  Pveg.  55  and  62,  where  ho  directs 
that  it  shall   be  of  a  shaggy  material   for 


CREDENCE 


255 


winter,  and  of  a  lighter  texture  for  summer 
wear,  lint  it  seems  to  have  been  worn 
before  the  time  of  Benedict  by  Eastern 
monks  and  nuns.  (Pallad.  Hist.  Laus.  38 
and  41.)  It  covered  the  head  and  shoulders, 
and  was  intended  to  be  symbolical  of 
humility,  being  worn  by  infants,  or  else  to 
prevent  the  wearer  from  looking  too  freely 
round  about  him.  (Cass.  Instit.  i.  5  ;  Sozom. 
Hist.  Ecdes.  iii.  13,  14.) 

CRAMP-RINGS.  A  ring  given  by  King 
Edward  (the  Confessor)  in  his  last  illness  to 
the  Abbot  of  Westminster  was  long  pre- 
served as  a  relic,  and  applied  to  the  cure  of 
nervous  diseases.  Afterwards  kings,  as  well 
as  "  touching  "  for  the  "  king's  evil,"  used,, 
on  Good  Friday,  to  bless  rings  for  the  same- 
purpose,  and  these  were  called  "cramp- 
rings." 

"The  king's  majesty,"  we  are  told  in 
Borde's  Breviarie,  "hath  a  greate  help& 
in  the  matter,  in  halowing  cramp-rings,  and 
so  given  without  money  or  petition."  There 
was  an  ofiice  in  English  for  the  blessing  of 
the  crami>rings,  which  is  given  by  Mr. 
Maskell  from  a  MS.  in  his  possession ;  but 
it  was  never  used  after  the  Pieformation,. 
although  it  was  revised  and  prepared  for  use 
in  the  reign  of  James  II.  A  Latin  form  of 
the  office,  similar  to  what  had  been  used  by 
Henry  VIII.,  was  prepared  for  Queen  Mary- 
in  1554.  Though  the  blessing  of  the  rings, 
with  a  religious  service,  no  longer  exists,  the 
tradition  remains;  and  in  the  north  of 
England,  and  in  Sweden  especially,  persons 
wear  rings  to  avert  cramp  or  rheumatism. — 
Wilkins'  Concil.  iv.  p.  103 ;  Pegge's  Curi- 
alia  Misc. ;  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  iii.  383.    [H.] 

CREDENCE,  or  CREDENTIAL.  A 
table  or  shelf  near  the  altar,  on  which  the 
bread  and  wine  to  be  used  in  the  Eucharist 
are  placed,  previously  to  consecration,  called 
in  the  Greek  Church,  rpdwe^a  npodio-eas, 
mensa  propositionis.  The  table  of  Prothesis- 
in  the  Greek  Church  is  placed  in  a  side 
vestry;  and  here  many  prefatory  prayers- 
and  ceremonies  are  performed,  before  th& 
priest  goes  into  the  chancel.  The  word. 
"  credence  "  appears  to  be  derived  from  the 
Italian  credenzare,  to  taste  meats  and 
drink  before  they  were  offered  to  be  enjoyed, 
by  another;  an  ancient  court  practice, 
which  was  performed  by  the  cup-bearers 
and  cai-vers,  who  for  this  reason  were  also- 
called  in  German  credenzer.  Hence,  also, 
the  credenz-teller — credence-plate,  on  which 
cup-bearers  credenced  the  wine;  and,  in 
general,  a  plate  on  which  a  person  offers 
anything  to  another :  credenz-tisch,  credence- 
table,  a  sideboard,  an  artificial  cupboard  with 
a  table  for  the  purpose  of  arranging  in  order' 
and  keeping  the  drinking  apparatus  therein. 
(See  Adelung's  German  Dictionary,  word 
"  Credenzen.")    Thia  table  or  shelf  is  used- 


256 


CREED 


for  tte  more  convenient  observance  of  the 
rubric  following  tke  Offertory  sentences,  in 
■which,  it  is  directed :  "  And  when  there  is  a 
communion,  the  priest  shall  then  place 
upon  the  table  so  much  bread  and  wine  as 
he  shall  think  sufficient."  Though  credences 
were  declared  illegal  by  the  Court  of  Arches 
in  Lichfield  v.  Faulkner,  that  judgment 
was  practically  reversed  by  the  Privy 
Council  in  Liddell  v.  Westerton,  and  they 
are  now  very  common. 

CREED.  By  the  word  creed  (from  credo, 
I  believe)  is  meant  the  substance  of  the 
Christian's  faith.  There  are  three  creeds 
recognised  by  the  Catholic  Church — the 
Apostles'  Creed,  the  Nicene  Creed,  and  the 
Athanasian  Creed.  The  Latin  name  for 
.  creed  is  symholum,  which  signifies  a  watch- 
word, or  signal  in  war.  Ludolph  of  Saxony, 
in  his  Life  of  Christ,  describes  the  creeds  of 
the  Catholic  Church  thus :  "  There  are 
three  sjrmbols  (watchwords  or  tokens,  such 
as  are  used  among  soldiers  of  a  garrison, 
to  recognise  their  comrades,  and  to  detect 
insidious  intniders),  the  first  of  the  Apostles, 
the  second  of  the  Nicene  Council,  the  third 
of  St.  Athanasius ;  the  first  for  instruction 
in  the  faith,  the  second  for  the  explanation 
of  the  faith,  the  third  for  defence  of  the 
faith."  Three  in  name,  but  one  in  fact,  and 
which,  except  a  man  believe  faithfully,  he 
cannot  be  saved. 

The  cause  of  a  gradual  adoption  of  a  series 
of  creeds  is  simply  this :  the  truth  being 
but  one  and  unvarying,  the  plain  assertion 
of  it  is,  in  the  first  instance,  all  that  is 
necessary,  all  that  can  be  done  for  it ;  and 
-this  was  done  by  the  Apostles'  Creed.  Error, 
■on  the  other  hand,  is  multiform ;  and  conse- 
quently, as  error  upon  error  continued  to 
rise,  correctives,  unthought  of  before,  were 
to  be  found  to  meet  the  exigency :  hence 
the  Nicene  Creed.  Again,  subsequent  to 
.  that,  new  errors  were  broached,  the  old  were 
revived,  clever  evasions  of  the  terms  of  the 
existing  creeds  were  invented,  the  vehemence 
of  opponents  was  increased  ;  but  all  desiring 
still,  with  all  their  mischievous  errors,  to  be 
within  the  pale  of  the  Church,  it  became 
still  more  imperatively  necessary  to  fence  in 
the  Church  from  such  dangers :  and  the 
creed  called  that  of  St.  Athanasius  was 
compiled  from  the  logical  forms  of  expression 
which  prevail  in  his  writings,  and  those  of 
similar  champions  of  the  Catholic  faith,  and 
was  very  soon  adopted  by  the  Church  as  an 
additional  bulwark  to  preserve  that  faith  in 
its  original  integrity  and  purity.  Luther 
calls  this  creed  "  the  bulwark  of  the 
Apostles'  Creed." 

It  is  a  mistake  to  imagine  that  creeds 
were  at  first  intended  to  teach,  in  full  and 
explicit  terms,  all  that  should  be  necessary 
ito  be  believed  by  Christians.    They  were 


CREED,  APOSTLES' 

designed  rather  for  hints  and  minutes  of  the 
main  credenda,  to  be  recited  by  catechumens 
before  baptism ;  and  they  were  purposely 
contrived  short,  that  they  might  be  the  more 
easily  retained  in  memory,  and  take  up  the 
less  time  in  reciting.  Creeds  very  probablj'-, 
at  first,  were  so  far  from  being  paraphrases 
or  explications  of  the  form  of  baptism  (or  of 
Scripture  texts),  that  they  went  no  farther, 
or  very  little  farther,  than  the  form  itself, 
and  wanted  as  much  explaining  and  para^ 
phrasing,  in  order  to  be  rightly  and  distinctly 
understood,  as  any  other  words  or  forms 
could  do.  Hence  it  was  that  the  cate- 
chumens were  to  be  instructed  in  the 
creed,  previously  to  baptism,  for  many  days 
together.  As  heresies  gave  occasion,  new 
articles  were  inserted;  not  that  they  were 
originally  of  greater  importance  than  any 
other  articles  omitted,  but  the  opposition 
made  to  some  doctrines  rendered  it  the  more 
necessary  to  insist  upon  an  explicit  belief 
and  profession  of  them. — Waterland's  Ser- 
mons on  the  Divinity  of  Christ. 

CREED,  THE  APOSTLES'.  The  great 
creed  of  the  West.  L  This  is  a  type  of  the 
simplest  kind  of  creed,  growing  up  freely, 
and  with  local  variations,  out  of  the  Bap- 
tismal Confession:  originally  preserved  by 
oral  recitation,  and  not  written ;  having  in 
itself  no  polemical  purpose,  and  no  anathema 
appended  to  it ;  but  intended  only  to  bring 
out  with  clearness,  simplicity,  and  due  pro- 
portion, the  essential  rudiments  of  the 
Christian  .faith.  It  is  the  creed  accepted 
by  our  Church  in  BajDtism,  taught  in  the 
Catechism,  used  daUy  in  the  Services,  and 
taken  as  the  test  of  Christian  faith  in  the 
dying  (see  Visitation  of  Sick)  ;  as  containing 
the  absolute  essentials  of  true  Christianity. 

11.  History. — Of  creeds  we  have  embryo 
formations  in  Scripture  (see  1  Cor.  sv.  3-8  ; 
Heb.  vL  1,  2;  1  Tim.  iii.  16),  in  which 
doctrine  is  moulded  into  a  formal  definite 
shape.  It  seems  impossible  to  doubt  that 
the  Apostles  had  some  "  form  "  of  creed,  and 
there  is  a  tradition  that  each  Apostle  con- 
tributed an  article,  beginning  with  St.  Peter 
and  ending  with  St.  Matthias  (Aug.  de 
Tempore  Ser.  115).  But  the  words  as- 
signed to  St.  Matthias,  "the  life  everlast- 
ing," are  clearly  proved  to  have  been  added 
at  a  comparatively  late  period ;  and  the  same 
may  be  said  of  the  article  on  the  descent  into 
hell  (Hades)  assigned  to  St.  Thomas. — 
Pearson  on  Creed,  art.  v.  225. 

"  But  though,"  says  Lord  Chancellor  King, 
"  this  Creed  be  not  of  the  Apostles'  imme- 
diate framing,  yet  it  may  be  truly  styled 
apostolical,  not  only  because  it  contains 
the  sum  of  the  Apostles'  doctrine,  but 
also  because  the  age  thereof  is  so  great, 
that  its  birth  must  be  fetched  from  the 
very  apostolic  times.     It  is  true,  the  exact 


CEEED,  APOSTLES' 

form  of  the  present  Creed  cannot  pretend 
to  be  so  ancient  by  four  hundred  years ; 
but  a  form,  not  much  different  from  it, 
was  used  long  before.  Irenajus,  the  scholar 
of  Polycarp,  the  disciple  of  St.  John,  where 
he  repeats  a  creed  not  much  unlike  to  ours, 
assures  us,  that  'the  Church,  dispersed 
throughout  the  whole  world,  had  received 
this  faith  from  the  Apostles  and  their 
disciples ; '  which  is  also  affirmed  by  Ter- 
tullian,  that  'the  rule  of  faith  had  been 
current  in  the  Church  from  the  beginning 
of  the  Grospel : '  and,  which  is  observable, 
although  there  was  so  great  a  diversity  of 
creeds,  as  that  scarce  two  Churches  did 
exactly  agree  therein,  yet  the  foim  and 
substance  of  every  creed  was  in  a  great 
measure  the  same ;  so  that,  except  there 
had  been,  from  the  very  plantation  of 
Christianity,  a  form  of  sound  words,  or  a 
system  of  faith,  delivered  by  the  first 
planters  thereof,  it  is  not  easy  to  conceive 
how  all  Churches  should  harmonize,  not 
only  in  the  articles  themselves  into  which 
they  were  baptized,  but,  in  a  great  measure 
also,  in  the  method  and  order  of  them." 
(^History  of  the  Apostles'  Creed:  which  G. 
Olearius  translated  into  Latin  and  published, 
Leips.  1704.) 

The  words  of  Irenaeus,  who  wrote  about 
A.D.  180,  here  referred  to,  are  not  a  creed, 
but  a  summary  of  Christian  doctrine,  re- 
sembling, indeed,  our  Creed  in  many  of  the 
expressions.  The  Creed  originally  was  not 
allowed  to  be  written,  but  was  to  be  learnt, 
as  is  evident  from  many  passages  in  the 
early  writers.  Thus  St.  Augustine  says, 
"  The  handling  of  the  faith  is  of  service  for 
the  protection  of  the  Creed ;  not,  however, 
that  this  should  itself  be  given  instead  of 
the  Creed,  [which  is  to  be]  committed  to 
memory,  and  repeated  by  those  who  are 
receiving  the  grace  of  God,  but  that  it  may 
guard  the  matters  which  are  retained  in  the 
Creed  against  the  insidious  assaults  of  the 
heretics,  by  means  of  Catholic  Authority, 
and  a  more  entrenched  defence."  (On  Faith 
and  the  Creed,  c.  i.)  Irena3us"s  summary 
may  be  translated,  "  The  Church,  dispersed 
as  it  is,  holds  one  faith  received  from  the 
Apostles  and  their  followers— the  belief  in 
one  God  the  Father  Almighty,  Maker  of 
heaven  and  earth,  the  sea,  and  all  things  in 
them :  and  in  one  Christ  Jesus  the  Son  of 
God,  who  was  incarnate  for  our  salvation  ; 
and  in  the  Holy  Ghost,  who  by  the  prophets 
proclaimed  the  dispensation  and  advent  of 
our  dear  Lord,  and  his  birth  of  a  Virgin, 
and  His  suffering,  and  his  llesurrection,  and 
His  Ascension  in  the  flesh,  into  heaven,  and 
His  coming  again  from  heaven  in  the  Glory 
of  the  Father,  to  sum  up  all  things,  and  to 
raise  up  all  flesh  of  the  whole  human  race." 
(Lib.  i.  cc.  i.,  ii.,  and   iii.)     Origen,  some 


CEEED,  APOSTLES' 


257 


forty  years  later,  gave  another  such  form  of 
apostolical  doctrine,  in  his  books  of  Chris- 
tian Principles  (n-tpi  dpxaiv),  and  Tertul- 
liau's  words,  to  which  reference  is  made  by 
Lord  Chancellor  King  as  quoted  above,  re- 
semble very  closely  our  Creed,  though  not 
in  that  form  (De  Yeland.  Virgin,  c.  i. ;  also 
de  Prsescript.  advers.  Hieret.  cc.  13,  14,  and 
elsewhere). 

From  St.  Cyprian's  writings  it  appears 
that  a  creed  used  in  his  time  (248-258) 
embraced  belief  in  the  Fathei-,  the  Son,  and 
the  Holy  Ghost,  together  with  the  forgive- 
ness of  sins,  and  the  life  everlasting.  (Ep. 
Ixix.,  ad  Magnum ;  Ep.  Ixx.,  ad  Episc. 
Numid.  &c.)  With  this  is  to  be  compared 
the  treatise  de  Trinitate  of  Novatian  about 
ten  years  later,  in  which  traces  of  a  similar 
creed  are  to  be  found  (Migne,  vol.  iii.  p.  886). 
Socrates  gives  an  account  of  a  creed  written 
by  Lucian,  a  presbyter  of  Antioch,  cir.  311 
(S.  E.  ii.  10).  A  few  years  afterwards 
came  the  great  Council  of  Nicaja  (see  Creed, 
Nieene).  But  in  the  West  the  teaching 
long  continued  :  "  Symbolum  non  in  tabulis 
scribitur,  sed  in  corde  receptum  memoriter 
retinetur"  (Mabillon,  de  Lit.  Call.  340). 
The  first  written  creed  in  the  West  is  one 
which  Marcellus,  bishop  of  Ancyra,  in  Ga- 
latia,  set  forth  in  a  letter  to  Pope  Julius  L, 
to  testify  the  purity  of  his  faith,  for  he 
had  been  banished  through  the  influence 
of  the  Arians.  As  it  was  accepted,  and 
Marcellus  was  received  into  communion 
by  the  Pope,  it  may  be  supposed  that  it 
was  in  accordance  with  the  Creed  used  at 
Rome ;  and  indeed  it  is  very  similar  to  the 
"  Apostles'  Creed  "  in  form.  Eufiinus,  or 
Eufinus  (who  asserts  that  this  Creed  had 
never  been  written  before  in  a  continuous 
form),  a  priest  of  Aquileia,  has  preserved 
the  two  versions  of  the  Creed  used  re- 
spectively in  the  Churches  of  Eome  and 
Aquileia  in  his  day,  a.d.  390  (Ruifin.  Expos, 
de  Symlol.'). 

In  the  Aquileian  Creed  the  words  "in- 
visible and  impassible"  occur  after  "the 
Father  Almighty;"  and  in  the  sentence  on 
the  resurrection,  the  word  "  this  "  is  inserted 
— "  hujus  carnis  resurrectionis."  In  the 
Eoman  form  the  words  "  descended  into 
hell"  are  not  found:  in  neither  Creed, 
"  Maker  of  heaven  and  earth  ; "  which  are 
first  found  in  two  baptismal  creeds  of  the 
Gallican  Church.  (Heurtley's  Harm.  Symb. 
pp.  68, 110.) 

The  clauses  "conceived  by  the  Holy 
Ghost,  born  of  the  Virgin  Mary  " ;  "  suffered, 
dead";  "God  (the  Father)  Almighty"; 
"  the  communion  of  Saints  " ;  "  the  life  ever- 
lasting " ;  and  the  word  "  Catholic,"  were  also 
later  additions.  The  exact  words  of  the 
Creed,  as  at  present  used,  are  first  to  bo 
found,  it  is  said,  in  a  work  by  Pirminius,  a 

s 


258 


CEEED,  APOSTLES' 


bisliop  in  Gaul,  aloout  750.  (This  is 
published  by  Mabillon  from  an  ancient 
MS.,  "Libellus  Pirminii  de  singulis  Ubris 
Canoniois  soarapsus  "  (  ?  "  scriptus  "). 

The  following  list  shows  the  gradual 
stages  in  the  form  of  the  Apostles'  Creed. 

(1)  Cyprian,  a.d.  250,  wrote,  "  I  believe  in 
God  the  Father,  in  Christ  the  Son,  in  the 
Holy  Ghost,  through  the  Holy   Church." 

(2)  Novatian,  in  a.d.  260,  added  "Al- 
mighty" after  "Father";  "Jesus"  before 
"  Christ "  ; "  our  Lord  God  "  after  the  "  Son." 

(3)  MaroeUus'  Creed  (a.d.  341)  was,  "I 
believe  in  God  Almighty  and  in  Jesus 
Christ  His  only  begotten  Son  our  Lord, 
from  the  Holy  Ghost  born,  and  Mary  the 
Virgin ;  under  Pontius  Pilate  crucified  and 
buried:  and  on  the  third  day  rose  again 
from  the  dead,  ascended  in  heaven,  and 
sitteth  on  the  right  hand  of  the  Father, 
from  thence  He  shall  come  to  judge  the 
quick  and  the  dead ;  and  in  the  Holy  Ghost, 
the  Holy  Church,  the  forgiveness  of  sins ; 
the  resurrection  of  the  body ;  the  ife  ever- 
lasting." (4)  Rufinus  (see  above),  a.d. 
390 ;  Augustine  of  Hippo,  a.d.  400 ;  Nicetas, 
A.D.  450,  who  added  the  word  "  CathoUc  " ; 
Eusebius  Gallus,  circ.  A.D.  550,  who  inserted 
the  words  "  was  conceived  by  "  ;  "  dead," 
and  "  the  Communion  of  Saints  "  ;  'all  have 
forms  with  little  variation ;  and  (5)  finally 
we  have  Pirminius'  Apostolic  Creed,  a.d. 
750,  in  the  same  form  as  it  at  present  exists. 

A  creed  in  Saxon  characters  is  preserved 
at  the  end  of  Athelstan's  Psalter,  which 
has  omissions  similar  to  those  of  Aquileia ; 
and  is  of  great  antiquity.  A  large  number 
of  Early  English  versions  areextant,  differing, 
of  course,  in  words  and  spelling,  but  similar 
in  substance.  Several  are  given  from  MSS. 
in  the  British  Museum,  &c.,  by  Mr.  Maskell 
(Mon.  Bit.  iiL  251  seq.,  ed.  1882). 

III.  It  is  impossible  to  trace  when  the 
Apostolic  Creed  was  introduced  into  the 
daily  services  of  the  Church.  Amalarius, 
a  deacon  of  Metz  (circ.  820),  speaks  of  the 
creed  as  used  in  the  office  of  Prime.  This 
was  not  necessarily  the  extended  form  of 
Pirminius;  but  after  a  time  that  became 
the  accepted  form. 

In  the  early  English  Church  the  Apostles' 
Creed  was  used  at  prime :  later  on  it  was 
said  by  the  choir  before  the  lessons  at 
Matins,  and  inaudibly  (except  the  last 
clause)  by  the  priest  at  the  commencement 
of  prime  and  compline.  Guignonius  (see 
Breviary)  directed  that  the  Apostles'  Creed 
should  he  used  on  all  days  except  Sunday, 
and  the  Athanasian  Creed  on  Sundays.  The 
Prayer  Book  of  1549  directs  the  Apostles' 
Creed  to  be  said  by  the  minister;  that  of 
1552  by  the  minister  and  people.  It  is  to 
be  said  or  sung  standing.  (See  also  East.) 

The  American   Liturgy  has   this  rubric 


CEEED,  ATHANASIAN 

before  the  Creed :  "  and  any  Church  may 
omit  the  words  '  He  descended  into  hell,' 
or  may  instead  of  them  use  the  words 
'  He  went  into  the  place  of  departed  spirits,' 
which  are  considered  as  words  of  the  same 
meaning  in  the  Creed ; "  and  it  also  allows 
the  Nicene  Creed  to  be  used  instead  of  the 
Apostles'  Creed.  (See  Smith  and  Wace,  Diet. 
Eccles.  Biog.,  &c.,  p.  695  seq.;  also  Diet. 
Christ.  Antiq.  ;  Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim, 
i.  71,  457;  Bingham,  bk.  x.  3;  Bishop 
Barry's  P.  B. ;  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  i.  36 ; 
Dr.  Lumby  in  S.  P.  C.  K.  Prayer  Booh ; 
Heurtley's  Ilarmonia  Symboliea.)     [H.] 

CEEED,  THE  ATHANASIAN.  In 
this  article  it  is  proposed  to  treat  succinctly 
of,  I.  The  language  in  which  the  Creed  was 
originally  written;  II.  Date;  III.  Author- 
ship ;  IV.  Titles ;  V.  Use  and  reception  in  the 
Church  Cathoho ;  VI.  Use  and  reception  in 
the  Church  of  England  in  modem  times. 

I.  2'he  original  Language.  —  On  this 
point  the  following  passage  from  Waterland 
is  conclusive  :  "  I'he  style  and  phraseology 
of  the  Creed ;  its  early  reception  among  the 
Latins,  while  unkno^ni  to  the  Greeks ;  the 
antiquity  and  number  of  the  Latin  manu- 
scripts, and  their  agreement  (for  the  most 
part)  with  each  other,  compared  with  the 
lateness,  scarceness,  and  disagreement  of  the 
Greek  copies,  all  concur  to  demonstrate  that 
this  Creed  was  originally  a  Latin  composure 
rather  than  a  Greek  one :  and  as  to  any 
other  language  besides  these  two  none  is 
pretended."  (Waterland's  Critical  History 
of  the  Athanasian  Creed,  p.  66.  Oxford 
edition,  1870.)  To  these  reasons  for  be- 
lieving in  a  Latin  original  it  might  be  added, 
as,  if  possible,  a  still  more  cogent  argument, 
that  much  of  the  terminology  of  the  Creed  in 
reference  both  to  the  Trinity  and  the  In- 
carnation is  distinctly  Augustinian,  obviously 
drawn  from  the  writings  of  the  great  Father 
of  Western  Theology,  while  at  the  same 
time  it  contains  several  expressions  which 
are  no  less  clearly  traceable  to  another  Latui 
Father—  St.  Vincent  of  Lerins.  In  proof  of 
this  it  is  suiBcient  to  refer  to  the  parallel 
passages,  which  have  been  arranged  by 
Waterland  side  by  side  with  the  Creed,  and 
at  the  bottom  of  the  page.  (^Ibid.  pp.  176- 
191.) 

II.  The  Date. — We  may  arrive  at  an 
approximate  determination  of  this  pomt. 
Within  the  necessary  limits  of  the  present 
article  it  would  be  impossible  to  attempt  a 
full  and  adequate  exposition  of  the  argument 
from  external  and  internal  evidence,  by 
which  the  antiquity  of  the  Quicunque 
vult  may  be  proved.  We  can  do  little 
more  than  give  a  general  outline  of  it. 
There  is  abundant  and  clear  evidence  that 
at  the  commencement  of  the  ninth  century 
the  Athanasian  Creed  was  not  only  extant 


CEBED,  ATHANASIAN 

in  its  entirety,  as  we  now  have  it,  but  was 
used  in  the  offices  of  the  Church,  and  was 
commonly  regarded  as  the  genume  work  of 
St.  Athanasius.  And  these  two  facts  would 
alone  establish  for  it  a  previous  existence  of 
some  considerable  duration.  The  people  of 
the  ninth  century  would  not  have  believed 
a  document,  which  they  knew  to  be  the 
product  of  their  own  age,  or  of  an  age 
shortly  preceding  their  o'tt'n,  to  be  the  com- 
jwsition  of  a  man  who  had  died  more  than 
four  hundred  years  before ;  nor  would  a 
formulary  be  recited  in  the  services  of  the 
Church  immediately  after  its  construction. 
It  must  first  become  known  and  gain  esteem 
and  credit  and  authority :  and  this  is  the 
work  of  time.  Considering  the  great  scarcity 
of  MSS.  earher  than  the  ninth  century, 
which  have  survived  the  wreck  of  a  thou- 
sand years  and  more,  to  expect  to  find 
numerous  copies  of  the  Athanasian  Creed, 
which  can  claim  such  a  remote  antiquity, 
would  be  unreasonable.  But  there  are  four 
extant  codices  of  it,  which  have  been 
assigned  by  competent  authorities  to  tlie 
eighth  century.  That  there  should  be  so 
many,  is  alone  a  proof  of  its  antiquity.  A 
fifth  belonging  to  the  same  period,  which 
was  extant  in  the  last  century,  is  probably 
now  lost.  Of  the  four  MSS.  at  present 
extant  three  are  placed  at  the  close  of  the 
century,  and  of  these  three  one  is  hnperfect 
owing  to  mutilation.  The  fourth  is  the 
only  one  which  requires  any  special  notice 
at  present,  because  it  is  the  earhest  known 
MS.  of  the  Creed.  It  is  deposited  in  the 
Ambrosian  Library  at  Milan.  Muratori, 
who  was  custodian  of  the  library  at  the  end 
of  the  seventeenth  century,  confidently 
assigned  it  to  the  close  of  the  seventh 
century;  Montfaucon  believed  it  to  have 
been  written  in  the  eighth ;  and  the  present 
learned  librarian  agrees  with  Montfaucon  as 
to  the  date.  No  paljeographical  authority 
has  ever  placed  it  later  than  the  eighth 
century.  The  Creed  is  introduced  without 
any  title,  and  is  given  in  its  entu-ety  with 
certain  verbal  variations,  some  of  which, 
being  evidently  the  result  of  mere  careless- 
ness on  the  part  of  the  scribe,  are  an  obvious 
proof  that  he  was  transcribing  from  an 
earlier  copy.  There  is  another  MS.  of  the 
eighth  century,  as  it  is  imiversally  judged 
to  be,  which  cannot  be  passed  by  in  silence ; 
for,  though  not  a  copy  of  the  Quicunque,  it 
supplies  distinct  evidence  of  its  high  an- 
tiquity. It  is  commonly,  but  most  in- 
accurately, spoken  of  as  the  Colbertine  MS. 
of  the  Athanasian  Creed.  It  was  once  the 
property  of  the  minister  Colbert,  and  is  now 
in  the  Bibliotheque  Nationale  at  Paris ;  it 
contains  a  collection  of  canons.  Among  the 
contents  appears  a  fragment,  found  by  the 
scribe,  according  to  his  ovm  statement,  at 


CREED,  ATHANASIAN 


259 


Treves,  of  a  sermon,  which  was  evidently 
addressed  to  Catechumens  at  the  Traditio 
Symholi  previous  to  baptism  :  for  there  is 
an  express  reference  to  this  ceremony.  This 
document,  without  actually  quoting  the 
Quicunque,  bears  a  sufficiently  close  re- 
semblance to  it,  notwithstanding  large  va- 
riations, to  show  that  the  preacher  was  well 
acquainted  with  our  Creed.  He  appears  to 
have  kno^vn  it  by  heart,  and  accordingly 
adapts  its  language  for  teaching  the  doctrine 
of  the  Incarnation,  amplifying  and  altering 
to  suit  the  occasion.  Not  less  than  thirteen 
verses  are  thus  made  use  of.  Now  the  date 
of  the  Paris  manuscript,  and  that  of  the 
sermon,  of  which  it  preserves  a  fragment, 
are  obviously  two  distinct  matters.  The 
sermon  must  have  been  composed  and 
preached  some  considerable  time  before  it 
was  found  in  a  fragmentary  state  at  Treves 
by  the  writer  of  the  Paris  MS.  We  carmot 
suppose  it  to  be  later  than  the  seventh 
century,  and  it  may  not  improbably  have 
been  a  work  of  the  sixth.  But  whenever  it 
was  composed,  the  Athanasian  Creed,  being 
obviously  well  kno^vn  to  the  preacher,  must 
have  been  then  in  existence,  and  probably 
had  been  so  for  some  time  ;  otherwise  it 
would  not  have  been  so  familiar  to  theo- 
logians of  the  day.  So  that  this  MS.  carries 
up  the  existence  of  the  Creed  certainly  to 
the  early  part  of  the  seventh  century, 
probably  earlier.  Though  we  cannot  pro- 
duce any  MS.  of  the  Quicunque  of  a  date 
prior  to  the  eighth  century,  we  are  able  to 
point  to  yet  more  ancient  testimonies  of  its 
use  or  existence.  Such  is  the  Canon  of 
Autun  enacted  about  a.d.  670,  at  a  synod 
which  was  presided  over  by  Leodegar,  or 
St.  Leger,  bishop  of  that  city.  This  canon 
enjoins  the  correct  recital  of  the  Creed  by 
the  clergy,  and,  it  is  particularly  to  be  noted, 
describes  it  as  "  The  Faith  of  the  Holy 
Athanasius  Prelate."  There  is  a  com- 
mentary extant  on  the  Quicunque,  which 
may  -ndth  good  reason  be  assigned  to  the 
beginning  of  the  eighth  century  or  the  close 
of  the  seventh.  This  we  shall  by  and  by 
refer  to  as  the  Oratorian  Commentary,  by 
which  title  it  has  been  described.  (See 
Early  History  of  the  Athanasian  Creed,  by 
G.  D.  W.  Ommanney,  pp.  32, 33.)  Another, 
from  its  emphatic  allusions  to  the  two  wiUs 
and  two  operations  in  our  Lord's  person, 
appears  to  belong  to  the  period  when  the 
Monothelete  controversy  was  raging — the 
middle  of  the  seventh  century  or  a  little 
after.  This  has  been  described  as  •  the 
Troyes  Commentary.  (Ibid.  pp.  32,  33.) 
In  regard  to  a  third — the  commentary  which 
has  been  commonly  attributed,  though  upon 
uncertain  grounds,  to  Venantius  Fortunatus 
— the  absence  of  any  of  the  terms  peculiar 
to   that   controversj"-,  together  with   other 

s  2 


260 


OBEED,  ATHANASIAN 


internal  evidence,  points  to  the  beginning  of 
the  seventh  century  or  the  close  of  the  sixth 
as  the  epoch  which  produced  it.  (See 
Athanasian  Creed:  Seasons  for  rejecting 
Mr.  Fmdkes's  theory  as  to  its  Age  and 
Author,  by  Professor  Heurtley ;  also  JEarly 
History  of  the  Athanasian  Creed,  by  G.  D. 
W.  Ommanney,  pp.  36,  37,  and  Athanasian 
Creed :  Examination  of  recent  Theories  re- 
specting its  Date  and  Origin,  by  the  same 
writer,  pp.  279-281.)  Our  last  testimony 
belongs  to  the  sixth  century.  The  Bal- 
lerini  brothers  cite  a  canon  or  rather 
capitulum  from  an  Epistola  Canonica,  which 
according  to  those  learned  canonists  was 
well  known  at  the  beginning  of  that  century 
— requiring  the  clergy  to  learn  by  heart  the 
"Fides  Catholica"  (^Editorum  Ohservationes 
III.  de  Auctore  SymboU  Quicunque  in 
Galland's  Sylloge  Dissertationum,  torn,  i.); 
and  they  contend,  that  by  this  title  nothing 
but  the  Athanasian  Creed  could  be  meant, 
inasmuch  as  the  laity  were  obliged  to  learn 
the  Apostles'  Creed  by  heart,  and  the  Nicene 
was  commonly  called  "  Fides  Nicena." 

It  is  essential  to  notice  that  the  preface  to 
the  Oratorian  Commentary  speaks   of  the 
Quicunque  as  being  attributed  to  St.  Athana- 
sius  m    old  manuscripts.     These   codices, 
which  were  considered  old  at  the  beginning 
of  the  eighth  century,  could  not  be  supposed 
to  be  later  than  the  conclusion  of  the  sixth 
century,    and  what  they  contained  must 
have  been  the  entire  Creed,  as  we  have  it 
at  the  present  day,  the  whole  of  it  being 
quoted  verse  by  verse  m  this  Commentary. 
Thus  from    the  testimonies  prior  to  the 
eighth  century  it  appears  that  the  Athana- 
sian Creed  was  in  the  seventh  century  the 
subject  of  commentaries,   and  of  a    local 
canon,  which  enjoined  its  recital  u^xin  the 
clergy,  that  so  early  as  the  latter  part  of 
the  sixth  century  it  was  regarded  as  tlie 
work  of  St.  Athanasius,  and  at  the  com- 
mencement   of    the     same    century    was 
ordered  by  an  ecclesiastical  document   of 
authority  to  be  learnt  by  the  clergy  by 
heart.    What  is  the  mevitable  conclusion, 
but  that  it  was  not  composed  later  than  the 
middle  of  the  fifth  century?    It  must  be 
borne  in  mind  that  a  Commentary  necessarily 
implies  the  pre-existence  of  some  duration 
of  the  document,  forming  its  subject-matter. 
And  similarly  the  Creed  must  have  been 
l^roduced  some  time  before  it  became  the 
subject  of  a  canonical  injunction,  and  was 
ascribed  to  a  wrong  authorship. 

The  conclusion  thus  arrived  at  upon 
external  grounds  is  confirmed  by  internal  evi- 
dence. Waterland  argues  from  the  absence 
of  any  express  mention  in  the  Quicunque  of 
the  two  natures  of  Our  Lord,  and  from  its 
use  of  an  illustration  respecting  them  which 
was  driven  out  by  the  Butychian  contro- 


CKEED,  ATHANASIAN 

versy,  that  it  must  have  been  drawn  up- 
before  the  Council  of  Chalcedon,  a.d.  451. 
A  comparison  of  our  Creed  with  the  Defi- 
nition of  Faith  adopted  at  that  council  may 
convince  any  one  of  the  truth  of  this 
position.  The  doctrinal  tenninology  of  the- 
former  document  is  clearly  prior  to  that  of 
the  latter.  For  the  most  part,  as  it  has 
been  already  remarked,  it  is  distinctly 
Augustinian.  On  the  other  hand,  the  fact 
that  the  language  of  the  Creed  is  lar*ely 
drawn  from  the  writings  of  St.  Augustine, 
is  an  obvious  proof  that  it  was  composed 
subsequently  to  the  latest  work  of  that 
Father,  from  which  its  materials  were 
derived.  Hence  the  date  of  the  Quicunque 
is  determined,  as  on  the  one  side  not  being 
later  than  a.d.  451,  and  on  the  other  not 
earlier  probably  than  428,  about  which  year 
the  second  book  against  Maximinus,  which, 
seems  to  have  been  one  of  the  sources  of  the 
Creed,  was  issued,  certainly  not  earlier  than 
420,  to  which  the  Enchiridion  and  the 
completion  of  the  work  on  the  Trinity  may 
be  approximately  assigned.  St.  Augustine- 
died  in  430. 

III.  The  Authorship. — The   Athanasian- 
Creed  being  of  Latin  origin,  and  its  phrase- 
ology being  largely  drawn  from  the  writings 
of  St.  Augustine,  it  follows  that  it  cannot  be 
a  genuine  work  of  the  illustrious  champion 
of  the  Catholic  Faith,  with  whose  name  it  is 
associated,  and  to  whom  it  was  universally 
ascribed  during  the  Middle  Ages.    Since  it 
ceased  to  be  considered  the  composition  of 
Athanasius,  it  has  been  attributed  to  several 
Latin  writers,  to  Vigilius  Tapsensisby  Quesnel 
and  Pagi  and  Bingham,  to  St.  Vincent  of 
Lerins  by  Antelmi,  to  Venantius  Fortunatus 
by    Muratori,  to    St.  Hilary  of  Aries   by 
Waterland,   and    to   Victricius,  bishop   of 
Rouen,  by  the  late  Mr.  Harvey.    To  St. 
Vincent  of  Lerins  alone  are  there  any  pro- 
bable reasons  for  assigning  it.     He  flourished 
at  the  very  period,  to  which,  as  we  have  seen, 
both  external  and  internal  evidence  point  as 
the   period  of   its   composition,  his    Com- 
monitorium  being  written  in  the  year  434, 
and  his  death  occurring  in  450 ;   and  there 
is  no  writer  of  that  epoch  to  whom  it  can 
be  attributed  with  equal  reason.     He  was  a 
native  and  a  monk  of  Gaul,  which  was  pro- 
bably the  birthplace  of  the  Creed,  a  writer 
upon  dogmatic  theology,  and  as  a  Galilean 
theologian   he    would   be  well   acquainted 
with  the  writings  of  St.  Augustine,  whose 
language    is    largely    reproduced    in    the 
Quicunque.     But  in   addition   to  all   this, 
there  is  a  special  reason  for  connecting  it 
with   the  author  of  the    Commonitorium^ 
inasmuch  as  both  in  the  part  relating  to  the 
Trinity  and  in  that  relating  to  the  Incarna- 
tion it  contains  several  expressions  which 
are  to  be  found  in  that  work,  but  do  not 


CREED,  ATHANASIAN 

occur  in  St.  Augustine.  Tliat  tliese  ex- 
pressions should  have  been  drawn  from  St. 
Vincent's  work  and  inserted  in  the  Creed  by 
another  hand  must  appear  very  improbable, 
if  we  believe  it  to  have  been  composed  not 
later  than  a.d.  451.  The  only  alternative 
is  that  the  author  of  the  Commonitorium 
was  also  the  author  of  the  Quicunqae.  Still, 
though  highly  probable,  this  cannot  be 
affirmed  with  certainty. 

IV.  Titles. — In  the  earliest  known  extant 
MS.  of  the  Athanasian  Creed,  already  men- 
tioned as  belonging  to  the  Ambrosian  Library 
at  Milan,  it  appears  without  any  title.  Nor 
has  it  any  in  a  Paris  MS.  of  the  end  of  the 
eighth  century.  In  the  Epistola  Canonica, 
assigned  by  the  Ballerini,  as  previously 
stated,  to  the  early  part  of  the  sixth  century, 
it  is  called  "  Fides  Catholica,"  and  this  is 
the  title  in  the  famous  Utrecht  Psalter,  the 
date  of  which  has  been  the  subject  of  a 
remarkable  difference  of  opinion  among 
palaeographers,  some  referring  it  to  the  sixth 
century,  others  not  considering  it  older  than 
the  eighth  or  ninth :  this  title  is  also  found 
in  the  Oxford  MS.  of  Portunatus'  Commen- 
tary, and  in  a  Wolfenbiittel  MS.  both  of  the 
ninth  century,  and  occasionally  in  later  MSS. 
This  is  probably  the  oldest  title.  Much 
more  frequently  it  is  expressly  assigned  to 
Athanasius,  as  in  the  Canon  of  Autun,  where 
it  is  described  as  "  Fides  sancti  Athanasi  pre- 
sulis  ; "  and  in  ancient  MSS.,  particularly 
Psalters,  it  is  commonly  designated  by  such 
titles  as  "  Fides  sancti  Athanasii  episcopi," 
or  "Fides  Catholica  sancti  Athanasii  epi- 
scopi," or  "  Fides  dicta  a  sanoto  Athanasio 
episcopo,"  or  the  like.  Sometimes,  but  with 
comparative  rarity,  the  term  "Sermo"  is 
applied  to  it.  The  earliest  instance  of  this 
is  to  be  found  in  a  canon  or  capitulum  of  a 
synod  held  atli,heims,in852,under  Hincmar, 
where  it  is  described  as  "  Sermo  Athanasii  de 
fide."  The  earliest  instances  known  to  the 
writer  of  its  being  called  "  Hymnus  "  are  of 
the  tenth  century,  in  two  Psalters,  both 
written  in  England,  one  belonging  to  the 
British  Museum,  the  other  to  the  Cathedral 
library  at  Salisbury.  In  both  it  has  the 
same  title:  "Hymnus  Athanasii  de  Fide 
IVinitatis."  Still  later  was  the  introduction 
of  the  word  "  Psalmus"  in  relerence  to  it  in 
the  title  "  Psalmus  Quicunque  vult."  The 
writer  is  not  aware  of  any  instance  of  this 
previous  to  the  thirteenth  century.  It 
should  be  borne  in  mind  that  there  is 
jiothing  inconsistent  with  its  position  as  a 
■XUreed  in  any  of  these  terms,  whether  sermo 
or  hymnus  or  psalmus.  No  specific  in- 
.  stance  of  "  symbolum "  being  used  in 
reference  to  it  can  apparently  be  adduced 
earlier  than  the  twelfth  century ;  but  from 
the  thirteenth  century  downwards  it  is 
-commonly  described  as  "  Symbolum  Qui- 


CEEED,  ATHANASIAN 


261 


cunque,"  or  "  Symbolum  Athanasii,"  and 
classed  as  one  of  the  three  symbols,  particu- 
larly in  Breviaries.  In  the  Sarum  Breviary 
it  is  headed  "Symbolum  Athanasii,"  and 
in  the  Roman  Breviary  "  Symbolum  S. 
Athanasii."  Waterland  is  certainly  mistaken 
in  saying  that  Hincmar  speaks  of  the 
Athanasian  Creed  as  a  "  Symbolum  "(Water- 
land's  Critical  History,  chap  xi.  p.  28, 
Oxford  edit.  1870),  the  Confession  of  Faith 
to  which  he  alludes  not  being  the  Quicunque, 
but  a  confession  entitled  "Fides  Homa- 
norum,"  sometimes  attributed  to  Athanasius. 
It  is  however  very  remarkable  that  in 
Psalters  of  the  Ambrosian  rite,  which  is 
highly  interesting  not  only  on  account  of  its 
great  antiquity,  but  because  it  is  in  living 
use  at  the  present  day,  the  Quicunque  is 
headed  simply  "  Symbolum." 

V.  Reception  and  use. — It  may  be  safely 
asserted  that  the  Athanasian  Creed  has  been 
received  and  used  in  the  Western  Church 
for  more  than  a  thousand  years.  We  do 
not  mean  to  claim  for  it  an  universal  recep- 
tion and  use  even  in  the  West  for  so  long  a 
period :  for  necessarily  it  was  received  and 
used  in  some  countries  and  local  Churches 
earlier  than  in  others.  To  suppose  that 
uniformity  of  ritual  was  generally  prevalent 
in  ancient  times  is  a  fallacy.  The  use  and 
reception  of  the  Quicunque,  which  had  been 
partial  previously,  ajDpears  to  have  become 
general  in  the  ninth  century,  and  universal 
throughout  Western  Chiistendom  at  the 
close  of  the  eleventh.  To  expect  full  and 
exact  information  respecting  its  history  in 
the  early  ages  of  its  existence  would  be  im- 
reasonable,  considering  the  extent  of  our 
ignorance  as  to  those  ages  and  how  very  few, 
comparatively  speaking,  of  the  MSS.  which 
they  produced  have  survived  to  our  times. 
The  evidence  is  but  limited  and  imperfect, 
and  it  could  not  be  otherwise.  But  so  far  as 
it  goes,  it  is  of  real  value. 

That  the  Athanasian  Creed  was  received 
and  used  in  the  offices  of  the  Church  in 
Northern  Italy  at  an  early  period,  appears 
probable  from  the  mere  fact  of  its  use  being 
enjoined  by  the  Ambrosian  rite,  having 
regard  to  the  great  antiquity  of  that  rite. 
But  we  have  direct  evidence  that  this  was 
the  case  as  early  as  the  sixth  century  in  the 
Epistola  Canonica — a  document  issued  by 
authority  apparently  in  some  province  or 
diocese  of  North  Italy. 

It  has  been  already  noticed  that  the  Com- 
mentary of  Fortunatus  may  be  assigned 
to  the  end  of  the  sixth  century  or  the  be- 
ginning of  the  seventh,  the  Troyes  to  the 
middle  of  the  seventh,  and  the  Oratorian  to 
the  end  of  the  seventh  or  the  early  part  of 
the  eighth.  These  Commentaries  most 
probably  were  all  drawn  up  in  Gaul.  And 
if  the  Athanasian  Creed  was  made  the  sub- 


262 


CEEED,  ATHANASIAN 


ject  of  commentaries  in  Gaul  in  the  seventh 
century,  it  must  have  been  known  and 
received  in  that  country  as  a  work  of 
authority,  and  a  true  exposition  of  the 
Catholic  Faith  in  the  sixth  century,  if  not 
earlier.  Comments  are  not  written  upon 
new  and  unaccredited  documents,  but  upon 
those  which  are  highly  and  generally  es- 
teemed for  their  intrinsic  value,  or  as  being 
invested  with  the  character  of  antiquity  or 
the  sanction  of  authority.  By  the  Canon  of 
Autun  we  are  led  to  believe  that  the  Qui- 
cunque  was  recited  in  the  Church  service 
in  the  seventh  century,  at  least  in  one 
diocese  of  Gaul.  For  why  should  the 
clergy  have  been  required  to  learn  it  by 
heart,  but  that  they  might  say  or  sing  it 
in  the  Church  ofiSces  ?  Of  its  use  and  re- 
ception in  Gtaul  from  the  time  of  Charle- 
magne downwards,  the  evidence  from  extant 
MSS.,  especially  Psalters,  and  Canons,  and 
the  testimonies  of  writers  by  way  of  quota- 
tion or  allusion  or  mention,  is  clear  and 
abundant.  In  our  limited  space  it  would 
be  impossible  to  notice  it  in  detail. 

With  regard  to  Germany,  the  Treves 
fragment  would  appear  to  indicate  that  the 
Athanasian  Creed  must  have  been  in  the 
hands  of  theologians,  at  least  in  that  city 
and  its  neighbourhood,  so  early  as  the 
seventh  century.  Of  its  use  and  reception 
in  Germany  in  the  ninth  century,  we  have 
evidence — in  a  capitulum  or  canonical 
injunction  of  Hatto  or  Aliyto,  bishop  of 
Basle,  about  a.d.  820,  requiring  the  recital 
of  the  Creed  by  the  clergy  at  the  service  of 
prime — -in  a  series  of  capitula,  also  enjoining 
its  vise,  which  were  drawn  up  within  the 
dominions  of  the  Emperor  Lothair,  for  the 
dominions  of  Lothair,  it  must  be  remembered, 
■were  co-extensive  at  one  period  with  those 
of  his  grandfather,  Charlemagne,  and  even 
after  the  treaty  of  Verdun  a.d.  843,  by 
which  they  were  limited,  they  still  em- 
braced part  of  Germany,  having  the  Rhine 
for  their  eastern  boundary — in  a  costly 
Psalter,  still  extant,  which  was  written  in 
honour  of  the  same  emperor,  and  which 
includes  the  Quicungue  among  its  contents 
{Early  History  of  the  Athanasian  Creed,  by 
G.  D.  W.  Ommanney,  p.  144,  also  pp.  167- 
70) — in  a  German  translation  of  our  Creed 
made  about  the  middle  of  the  century  by 
a  monk  of  Wissemburg  (Oatechesis  Tlieo- 
tisca.  Eccard.,  Hanov.  1713),  such  a  trans- 
ation  into  the  vernacular  being  a  clear 
proof  of  its  popular  and  long-established  use 
— ^in  the  admonition  of  Anschar,  archbishop 
of  Hamburg  and  Bremen,  addressed  to  his 
clergy  about  a.d.  865,  that  they  should  sing 
it — in  the  Constitutions  of  Eegino,  abbot  of 
Prum,  which  were  drawn  up  at  the  begin- 
ning of  the  tenth  century,  and  were  clearly 
founded  on  previously  existing  usage,  one 


CKEED,  ATHANASIAN 

of  them  enjoining  enquiry  to  be  made!' 
whether  the  clergy  were  in  the  habit  of 
learning  it  by  heart.  In  the  Imperial 
Library  at  Vienna  is  a  magnificent  Psalter,, 
containing  the  Quicunque,  which  is  stated 
upon  the  authority  of  ancient  records  to- 
have  been  presented  by  Charlemagne,  A.Dt 
788,  to  the  Church  of  Bremen. 

That  the  Athanasian  Creed  was  known 
and  received  in  England  in  the  eighth  cen- 
tury, we  have  proof  in  the  profession  of 
faith  made  by  Denebert,  a.d.  798,  on  his 
consecration  to  the  bishopric  of  Worcester, 
in  which  he  quotes  several  verses  of  the- 
Creed,  and  adopts  them  as  the  expression  of 
his  o^vn  faith  on  the  subject  of  the  Trinity. 
Of  the  use  of  the  Quicunque  in  the  offices 
of  the  English  Church  prior  to  the  Norman 
Conquest  there  are  visible  memorials  in 
Psalters  still  extant,  written  in  England,  in 
which  it  is  found  accompanied  with  an 
Anglo-Saxon  gloss  or  version.  Three  such 
Psalters  are  remaining,  which  are  assigned 
to  the  tenth  century,  one  being  in  the 
British  Museum,  another  in  the  Lambeth 
Library,  the  third  in  the  Cathedral  Library- 
at  Salisbury.  Abbo  of  Pleury  in  the  same 
century  refers  to  the  Creed  as  being  sung 
responsively  in  the  Church  of  England  as- 
well  as  in  France. 

It  is  remarkable  that  the  oldest  known 
MS.  of  the  Athanasian  Creed  is  written  in 
an  Irish  hand.  Before  it  was  transferred  at 
the  beginning  of  the  seventeenth  century 
to  its  present  domicile,  the  Ambrosian 
Library  at  Milan,  the  codex  containing  this- 
copy  was  the  property  of  the  monastery  of 
Bobbio  in  North  Italy,  which  was  founded 
by  the  Irish  Saint  Columbanus  a.d.  613. 
Being  in  an  Irish  hand,  it  must  clearly  have 
been  written  in  Ireland,  as  Dr.  Ceriani,  the 
Ambrosian  librarian,  thinks  most  probable,, 
or  in  one  of  the  monastic  offshoots  of  the 
Irish  Church  whether  in  Great  Britain  or  on 
the  Continent.  The  circumstance  points 
directly  to  the  inference,  that  our  Creed  was- 
known  and  esteemed  by  the  early  Irish 
Church,  a  point  of  great  interest,  considering 
the  independent  position  of  that  Church,  the 
peculiarities  of  its  organization  and  ritual,, 
and  its  great  missionary  activity.  And 
this  is  confirmed  by  another  Irish  MS.,  in 
which  the  Creed  appears,  a  Book  of  Hymns, 
at  present  deposited  in  the  church  of  the- 
Francisoans  on  Merchants'  Quay,  Dublin, 
and  written,  in  the  judgment  of  Dr.  Peeves 
of  Armagh,  not  later  than  a.d.  1100.  (See- 
Appendix  by  Dr.  Reeves  to  a  Sermon  by 
the  late  Archdeacon  Lee,  on  the  Athanasian 
Creed.) 

Of  the  early  use  and  reception  of  the 
Athanasian  Creed  in  Rome  and  Central  Italy 
we  have  no  precise  information ;  but  it  is- 
impossible  to  suppose  that  it  was  introduced 


CREED,  ATHANASIAN 

there  later  than  the  tenth  century,  consider- 
ing that  it  is  found  in  Psalters  both  of  the 
Eoman  or  Gregorian  and  of  the  Benedictine 
or  Monastic  rite,  considering  also  the  close 
intercommunion  which  existed  in  the  early 
Middle  Ages  between  Rome  and  countries 
where  we  have  evidence  of  the  Creed  being 
received  and  used  at  that  period. 

The  Athanasian  Creed  not  being  found 
in  Psalters  of  the  Mozarabic  rite,  would 
appear  not  to  have  been  used  in  the  offices 
of  the  Spanish  Church  until  the  latter  part 
of  the  eleventh  century,  when  that  rite  was 
superseded  in  Spain  by  the  Gallican. 

In  the  Western  Church  this  Creed  has 
been  always  sung  at  prime,  which  is  properly 
the  service  to  be  said  at  seven  in  the  morn- 
ing. Owing  to  its  being  thus  used  in  the 
Church  Offices,  it  is  commonly  found  at  the 
end  of  ancient  MS.  Psalters,  following  the 
Old  and  New  Testament  and  ecclesiastical 
canticles,  and  sometimes,  also,  the  Apostles' 
Creed  and  Lord's  Prayer,  more  rarely  the 
Nicene  or  Constantinopolitan  Creed ;  occa- 
sionally it  is  followed  by  a  litany  and 
prayers  and  hymns  and  collects.  Hence  its 
appearance  in  Psalters  is  evidence  of  its 
recital.  From  the  Psalters  it  passed  into 
Breviaries.  It  was  not  recited  with  the 
same  frequency  in  all  places  and  times  and 
rites.  In  the  Eoman  rite  it  was  said  on 
Sundays,  but  in  the  Ambrosian,  and  by 
some  religious  orders,  as  the  Carthusians  and 
Cluniacs,  every  day.  In  England  and 
Scotland  previous  to  the  Reformation,  it 
appears  also  to  have  been  recited  daily, 
according  to  the  Uses  of  Sarum  and  York  and 
Aberdeen.  In  Bishop  Hilsey's  Primer, 
issued  in  the  reign  of  Henry  VIII.,  a.d. 
1539,  it  is  called :  "  The  Symbol  or  Creed 
of  the  Great  Doctor  Athanasius,  daily  used 
in  the  Church."  Honorius  of  Autun  in  the 
twelfth  century  says  that  in  some  churches 
it  was  recited  daily  at  prime,  so  that  its 
daily  use  does  not  apjjear  to  have  been 
universal  at  that  time.  But  it  is  occasionally 
mentioned  earlier.  Thus  Martene  {De  An- 
tiquis  Bitibus  Ecclesia;,  lib.  iv.  cap.  viii.) 
refers  to  its  daily  recital  at  St.  Martin's, 
Tours,  in  the  tenth  century.  In  the  capi- 
tulum  of  Hatto  of  Basle,  already  noticed,  in 
the  early  part  of  the  ninth  century  it  was 
directed  to  be  recited  on  the  Lord's  Day  at 
prime. 

Two  circumstances  in  the  history  of  the 
Athanasian  Creed  must  here  be  noticed,  as 
evidence  of  its  wide  acceptance  and  general 
use  for  the  purposes  both  of  instruction  and 
devotion. 

First,  from  the  seventh  century  to  the 
fifteenth  inclusive,  it  was  the  subject  of 
numerous  commentaries.  The  writer  is  able 
to  reckon  no  fewer  than  twenty-seven  in 
Latin,  besides  one  in  English,  apparently  a 


CREED,  ATHAN'ASIA'N 


263 


Wicliffite  Avork,  and  no  doubt  there  are 
others  with  which  he  is  unacquainted. 
Several  of  these  consisted  originally  of 
marginal  notes  attached  to  the  text  of  the 
Creed  in  Psalters. 

Secondly,  it  hao  been  translated  into 
various  languages. 

Several  Psalters  are  existing,  as  has  been 
previously  mentioned,  written  before  the 
Norman  Conquest,  in  wliich  the  Creed 
appears  with  an  interlinear  Saxon  version 
or  gloss.  In  the  Eadwin  Psalter  of  the 
twelfth  century  it  is  accompanied  by  a 
Noimanno-Saxon  version.  In  a  British 
Museum  MS.  of  the  fourteenth  century, 
Addit.  17,376,  is  an  English  version  of  the 
Psalter — the  earliest,  as  is  believed,  in  ex- 
istence— with  the  Canticles  and  Quicunque 
also  in  English.  This  translation  is  attri- 
buted, but  on  uncertain  grounds,  to  William 
de  Schorham,  Vicar  of  Chart,  near  Ledes  in 
Kent.  A  later  English  translation,  probably 
by  a  follower  of  Wiclif,  occurs  in  several 
MSS.  of  the  fifteenth  century,  in  some 
being  subjoined  to  Psalters  of  Kichard  Ham- 
pole's  version,  in  others  to  Psalters  of  the 
later  Wicliffite  version.  'Iliis  translation  is 
clearly  by  the  same  hand  as  the  commentary 
above  referred  to,  as  they  accompany  one 
another.  The  translation  in  Bishop  Hilsey's 
Primer,  a.d.  1539,  is  distinct  from  both 
these,  apparently  made  for  the  occasion. 
And  that  which  appeared  in  the  first  Prayer 
Book  of  Edward  VI.,  a.d.  1549,  and 
which  is  substantially  the  same  as  our 
present  version,  the  variations  being  unim- 
portant, is  again  another  translation,  so  that 
the  fourteenth  and  two  following  centuries 
produced  no  fewer  than  four  difl'erent  English 
translations  of  the  Quicunque. 

And  in  Prance,  as  in  England,  it  has 
always  been  the  practice  to  render  the 
Athanasian  Creed  into  the  vernacular.  Thus 
Hincmar,  archbishop  of  Eheims,  in  his 
capitula  dated  a.d.  852,  charges  his  presby- 
ters not  only  to  commit  it  to  memory  and 
understand  its  meaning,  but  to  explain  it  in 
the  vernacular  (verbis  commujiibus  enun- 
tiare).  A  Romance  version  of  it  appears  in 
a  MS.  of  the  fourteenth  century  in  the 
Library  of  the  lllcole  de  Medecine  at  Mont- 
pellier.  The  version  itself  must  be  older 
than  the  fourteenth  century,  as  at  the 
commencement  of  that  century  the  Romance 
language  had  fallen  into  complete  decay. 
Montfaucou  in  his  Diatribe  gives  two  old 
French  versions  of  it,  one  dating  about  the 
end  of  the  eleventh  century,  another  about 
1300.  In  the  Eadwin  Psalter  at  Trinity 
College,  Cambridge,  which  is  assigned  to  tho 
reign  of  Stephen,  it  appears  with  what 
AVanley  calls  a  Normanno- Gallican  version. 
Monsieur  Michel  has  edited  from  a  British 
Museum  MS.    of    the   thirteenth  century 


264 


CREED,  ATHANASIAN 


(Cotton,  Nero,  c.  iv.)  a  French  version  of 
the  Apostles'  and  Athanasian  Creeds,  as  well 
as  the  Canticles,  and  from  a  MS.,  probably 
not  of  later  date,  belonging  to  the  Biblio- 
theque  Nationale  at  Paris,  a  metrical  version 
in  French  of  the  same  Creeds  and  the  Psalms 
and  New  Testament  Canticles.  (See  "  Epis- 
tola  ad  Lectorem  "  at  the  commencement  of 
"Libri  Psalmorum  versio  antiqua  Gallica, 
edidit  Franciscus  Michel."     Oxon.  1860.) 

There  are  several  German  translations  of 
the  Athanasian  Creed  of  various  ages.  The 
earliest,  as  has  been  already  mentioned, 
dates  as  far  back  as  the  ninth  century. 
It  has  been  preserved  in  a  AVolfenbiittel 
MS.  of  that  century,  which  originally  be- 
longed to  the  Abbey  of  Wissemburg.  In 
the  following  century  another  translation 
was  produced  by  Notkems  Balbulus.  Both 
of  these,  together  with  a  third,  rather  later, 
have  been  edited  in  Massmann's  "  Die 
Deutschen  Abschorungs-,  Glaubens-,  Beicht- 
und  Betformeln  vom  achten  bis  zum  zwolften 
Jahrhundert,"  Leipzig,  1839.  The  first  was 
originally  edited,  together  with  the  other 
contents  of  the  Wolfenbiittel  MS.,  by  G. 
Eccard  in  1713,  under  the  title  :  "  Incerti 
monaohi  Weissenburgensis  Catechesis  Theo- 
tisca  saBoulo  ix.  conscripta,  nunc  vero 
primum  edita.''  Waterland  refers  to  accounts 
of  later  German  versions  by  Lambecius, 
Tentzelius,  and  Le  Long,  but  more  particu- 
larly by  Tentzelius. 

This  brief  summary  is  sufficient  to  show 
that  the  Western  vernacular  versions  of  the 
Athanasian  Creed  are  not  only  numerous,  but 
extend  over  a  wide  range  of  years.  On  the 
other  hand,  the  Greek  translations  are  com- 
paratively few  and  late.  The  earliest  mention 
of  any  Greek  version  is  made  by  Nicolaus 
Hydruntius  about  a.d.  1200  ;  and  probably 
the  QuicunqtK  was  translated  into  Greek 
some  time  before.  But  none  of  the  Greek 
manuscripts  now  extant  date  so  high  even  as 
that.  Montfaucon  says  that  he  had  seen  none 
older  than  the  fifteenth  century.  Waterland 
gives  some  account  of'  those  which  were 
extant  in  his  time,  but  none  of  them  is 
assigned  by  him  to  an  earlier  date  than  the 
fourteenth  century.  Four  Greek  copies  may 
be  seen  in  Montfaucon's  "  Diatribe  in  Sym- 
bolum  Quicunque,"  in  the  second  volume 
of  the  Benedictine  edition  of  St.  Athanasius. 
Two  more,  one  from  a  MS.  in  St.  Mark's 
Library  at  Venice,  and  the  other  from  a  MS. 
in  the  Ambrosian  Library  at  Milan,  are 
edited  by  Caspari  in  his  Quellen,  vol.  iii.  pp. 
263-7. 

The  mention  of  the  comparative  scarcity 
and  lateness  of  Greek  versions  and  transla- 
tions brings  us  to  the  last  point  which 
requires  to  be  noticed  in  reference  to  use 
and  reception.  The  Athanasian  Creed,  as 
the  Apostles',  is  not  recited  in  the  oinces  of 


CEEED,  ATHANASIAK 

the  Eastern  Church  or  any  of  its  branches, 
nor  has  it  ever  been.  Its  position  in  the 
Russian  Church,  and  it  may  be  presumed  in 
the  Eastern  Church  generally,  is  thus  de- 
scritjed  by  Platow,  Archbishop  of  Moscow  : 
"Symbolum  sancti  Athanasii  ecclesia  nostra 
agnoscit,  et  inter  libros  ecclesiasticos  re- 
peritur,  et,  ut  ejus  fidem  sequamur,  in- 
culcatur,  tamen  nunquam  recitatur.  Satis 
pro  nobis  est,  quod  nihil  quidquam  in  se 
contineat,  quod  sanse  atque  orthodoxse  doc- 
trina3  non  sit  consentaneum."  (See  Nares 
On  the  Three  Creeds,  p.  82.)  It  is  added  at 
the  end  of  the  Great  Horologium  or  Book  of 
Hours,  which  was  printed  and  published  at 
Venice,  and  is  expressly  stated  on  the  title- 
page  to  be  "  in  accordance  with  the  rule  of  the 
Eastern  Church  of  Christ,"  and  a  note  is 
subjoined  declaring  it  to  be  agreeable  to  the 
mind  of  the  orthodox  Church.  But  it  must 
be  observed  that  the  words  "  and  the  Son  " 
are  omitted  in  the  verse  relating  to  the  Pro- 
cession of  the  Holy  Spirit. 

VI.  Use  and  reception  in  the  Cliurch  of 
England  in  modern  times. — In  the  first 
Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI.,  a.d.  1549,  the 
Athanasian  Creed  was  ordered  to  be  sung 
or  said  on  the  Feasts  of  Christmas,  the 
Epiphany,  Easter,  the  Ascension,  Pentecost, 
and  Trinity  Sunday.  But  in  the  second 
Prayer  Book  of  Edward,  which  was  adopted 
only  three  years  later,  in  1552,  its  recital 
was  required  on  seven  more  Feasts,  viz. :  St. 
Matthias,  St.  John  Baptist,  St.  James,  St. 
Bartholomew,  St.  Matthew,  St.  Simon  and 
St.  Jude,  and  St.  Andrew,  making  thirteen 
days  in  the  year  altogether.  And  no  altera- 
tion as  regards  the  days  of  its  recital  has 
been  made  by  any  subsequent  revision  of  the 
Prayer  Book.  The  increased  recital  enjoined 
by  the  second  Book  of  Edward  is  a  very 
notable  circumstance,  considering  that  on 
other  points  that  book  as  compared  with 
the  first  was  an  evident  departure  from 
previous  Catholic  usage.  It  has  been  ac- 
counted for  by  the  fact  that  the  excesses  of 
the  Anabaptists  and  other  fanatics  who 
traversed  the  country  openly  denying  the 
essential  doctrines  of  Christianity,  such  as 
the  Trinity  and  Incarnation,  had  alarmed 
the  minds  of  Cranmer  and  the  authorities 
of  the  Church,  and  led  them  to  attach  an 
increased  value  to  the  great  Confession  of 
the  Faith,  in  which  those  doctrines  are  most 
distinctly  and  explicitly  enunciated. 

In  both  these  books,  but  especially  the 
first,  there  was  an  apparent  inconsistency  in 
the  rubrics  referring  to  the  Apostles'  Creed 
and  that  of  St.  Athanasius.  In  the  book  of 
1549,  after  the  Benedictus  came  the  rubric, 
"  Then  shall  be  said  daily  through  the  year 
these  prayers  following,  as  well  at  Evensong 
as  at  Mattins,  all  devoutly  kneeling."  Then 
followed  the  short  Litany,  and  next  the 


CREED,  ATHAN ASIAN 

rubric,  "Then  the  minister  shall  say  the 
Creed  and  the  Lord's  Prayer  in  English  with 
a  loud  voice."  On  the  other  hand,  the 
rubric  preceding  the  Athanasian  Creed 
ordered  that  on  certain  Feasts,  already 
mentioned,  it  should  "  be  sung  or  said  im- 
mediately after  Benedictus."  The  incon- 
sistency, which  was  no  doubt  the  result  of 
haste  or  inadvertence,  is  obvious.  In  1552 
an  alteration  was  made  clearly  in  order  to 
remedy  the  difficulty.  The  Apostles'  Creed 
was  removed  from  its  previous  position  and 
placed  immediately  after  the  Benedictus,  or 
i-ather  the  Jubilate,  which  was  then  inserted 
as  an  alternative  canticle,  and  in  the  rubric 
preceding  it  the  words  "  daily  through  the 
year"  were  omitted;  it  ran  thus:  "Then 
shall  be  said  the  Creed  by  the  minister  and 
the  people  standing."  No  alteration  was 
made  in  the  rubric  preceding  the  Quicunqv^ 
vitlt  beyond  the  insertion  of  the  additional 
Peasts  on  which  it  was  to  be  recited.  But 
there  still  remained  a  want  of  harmony  in 
the  rubrics  taken  literally.  This  was  com- 
pletely rectified  at  the  Revision  in  1662, 
when  in  the  rubric  before  the  Apostles' 
Creed  the  words  were  introduced:  "Ex- 
cept only  such  days  as  the  Creed  of  St. 
Athanasius  is  appointed  to  be  read,"  and  in 
that  before  the  Quicunque  the  words  "  im- 
mediately after  Benedictus  "  were  altered  to 
■"  at  Morning  Prayer  instead  of  the  Apostles' 
Creed." 

In  the  latter  rubric  too  the  Quicunque 
was  described  as  "  His  Confession  of  our 
Christian  Faith,  commonly  called  the  Creed 
of  St.  Athanasius ; "  previously  it  had  been 
described  simply  as  "  this  Confession  of  our 
Christian  Faith."  There  is  every  reason  to 
believe  that  these  rubrics  of  1662  made  no 
practical  change — that  they  merely  gave  an 
express  sanction  to  the  established  usage. 
No  alteration  was  made  in  1662,  as  already 
remarked,  in  regard  to  the  frequency  of 
recital. 

It  must  be  borne  in  mind  that  the  Church 
of  England  since  the  Reformation  has  not 
only  constantly  maintained  the  use  of  the 
Creed  of  St.  Athanasius  in  her  services,  but 
lias  accepted  and  authorized  it  in  the  most 
emphatic  and  explicit  manner  by  declaring 
in  the  Thirty-nine  Articles,  which  were 
passed  by  Convocation  finally  in  the  year 
1571,  that  together  with  the  other  two 
Creeds  it  "  ought  thoroughly  to  be  received 
and  believed."  In  the  Latin  version  of  the 
Articles,  which  is  equally  authentic  with 
the  English,  as  both  versions  were  sub- 
mitted to  Convocation  in  1562,  it  is  entitled 
"  Symbolum,"  the  heading  of  the  eighth 
Article  being  "De  tribus  S3rmbolis,"  and 
the  three  Creeds  being  described  in  it,  as 
"  Symbola  tria,  Niccenum,  Athanasii  et  quod 
vulgo  Apostolorum  appellatur." 


CREED,  ATHANASIAN 


265 


On  two  occasions  since  the  last  Revisions, 
of  the  Prayer  Book,  it  has  been  proposed  to 
add  an  explanatory  note  to  the  Quicunque 
vidt,  with  the  view  of  satisfying  object 
tors.  lu  1689  a  commission  of  ten  bishops 
and  twenty  divines  was  appointed  "  to  pre- 
pare alterations  in  the  Liturgy  and  Canons  " 
and  for  other  purposes.  One  of  the  sugges- 
tions of  the  commissioners  was  to  add  the 
following  to  the  rubric  before  the  Athana- 
sian Creed : — "  The  Articles  of  which  ought 
to  be  received  and  believed,  as  being  agree- 
able to  the  Holy  Scriptures,  and  the  con- 
demning clauses  are  to  be  understood  as 
relating  only  to  those  who  obstinately  deny 
the  substance  of  the  Christian  faith."  This 
proposal  fell  to  the  ground  owing  to  the 
known  determination  of  the  Lower  House 
of  Convocation  to  reject  the  scheme  of  the 
commissioners  in  toto. 

The  other  proposal  of  a  similar  kind  was 
made  recently,  when  the  Church  was  con- 
vulsed by  a  controversy  respecting  the 
retention  of  the  Creed  in  her  services.  In 
an  amiable  desire  to  pour  oil  upon  the 
troubled  waters,  the  Convocation  of  the 
Province  of  Canterbury  adopted  in  the  year 
1873  the  following  declaration  : — "  For  the 
removal  of  doubts  and  to  prevent  disquietude 
in  the  use  of  the  Creed  commonly  called 
the  Creed  of  St.  Athanasius,  this  Synod 
doth  solemnly  declai'e: — 1.  That  the  Con- 
fession of  our  Christian  Faith,  commonly 
called  the  Creed  of  St.  Athanasius,  doth  not 
make  any  addition  to  the  faith  as  contained 
in  Holy  Scriptures,  but  warneth  against 
errors  which  from  time  to  time  have  arisen 
in  the  Church  of  Christ.  2.  That  as  Holy 
Scripture  in  divers  places  doth  promise  life 
to  them  that  believe  and  declare  the  con- 
demnation of  them  that  believe  not,  so  doth 
the  Church  in  this  Confession  declare  the 
necessity  for  all  who  would  be  in  a  state  of 
salvation  of  holding  fast  the  Catholic  Faith, 
and  the  great  peril  of  rejecting  the  same. 
Wherefore  the  warnings  in  this  Confession 
of  Faith  are  to  be  understood  no  otherwise 
than  like  warnings  in  Holy  Scripture,  for 
we  must  receive  God's  threatenings  even  as 
His  promises,  in  such  wise  as  they  are 
generally  set  forth  in  Holy  Writ.  Moreover 
the  Church  doth  not  herein  pronounce 
judgment  on  any  particular  person  or  persons, 
God  alone  being  the  Judge  of  all."  Happily 
this  ambiguous  utterance,  which  might 
more  fitly  be  designated  a  mystification  than 
an  explanation,  was  not  accepted  by  the 
Convocation  of  York,  the  bishops  of  that 
province  refusing  to  concur  in  it :  so  that  it 
cannot  be  regarded  as  the  voice  of  the  whole 
Church  of  England  represented  in  her 
lawful  synods.  In  this,  as  in  the  previous 
case,  the  result  was  nugatory ;  and  the 
Creed  retains  its  place  in  the  Prayer  Book 


266 


CKEED,  NicENE 


without  being  encumbered  by  a  so-called 
explanatory  note  or  declaratiou. 

It  does  not  come  within  the  scope  of  the 
present  article  to  reply  to  the  objections 
frequently  alleged  against  the  Quicunque, 
especially  the  so-called  damnatory  clauses, 
upon  dogmatic  grounds.  For  a  complete 
vindication  of  it  from  these  objections  the 
reader  may  be  referred  to  a  masterly  paper 
by  the  late  Professor  Mozley,  contained  in 
his  "  Lectures  and  other  Theological  Papers," 
published  by  Eivingtons,  1883.  [U.  D. 
W.  0.] 

CRP:ED,THE  NIOENE  ;  sometimes  called 
the  Constantinopolitan  Creed.  This  Creed 
was  chiefly  composed  by  the  orthodox  fathers 
of  the  first  general  Council  of  Nicjea,  a.d. 
325,  to  define  the  Christian  faith,  in  opposi- 
tion to  the  heresy  of  Arius. 

The  Church  for  three  hundred  years  had 
been ,  content  to  profess  in  her  Creed,  that 
Christ  was  the  Lord ;  comprehending,  under 
this  title,  the  highest  appellations  given  to 
Him  in  Scripture,  without  stating  minutely, 
or  scrutinizing  too  narrowly,  a  doctrine  pro- 
posed rather  to  us  as  an  object  of  faith  than 
of  understanding.  Happy  had  it  been  for 
the  Christian  world,  if  the  moderation  of  the 
Church  had  been  suffered  to  continue  ;  but 
Arius,  a  discontented  priest  of  Alexandria  in 
Egypt,  either  having  conceived  a  different 
opinion,  or  wishing  to  bring  himself  into 
notice  by  the  assertion  of  a  novelty,  took 
upon  him  to  maintain  that  Christ  was  not  a 
Divine  person,  in  the  highest  sense,  but  a 
creature,  superior  indeed  to  human  nature, 
but  not  a  partaker  of  the  supreme  Godhead. 

The  publishing  of  this  opinion  raised  a 
violent  ferment  and  schism  in  the  Church. 
Constantine,  the  Eoman  emperor,  summoned 
a  council  at  Nica;a,  in  Bithynia,  to  settle 
this  dispute;  and  there,  in  the  year  325, 
Arius'  doctrine  was  condemned  in  an 
assembly  of  300  bishops,  and  that  creed 
framed  which  from  the  name  of  the  city 
was  called  the  Nicene  Creed. 

To  the  early  creeds,  not  written  down  in 
a  set  form,  but  impUed  by  the  earliest 
writers,  reference  is  made  in  the  article  on 
the  "  Apostles'  Creed."  The  original  form 
of  the  Nicene  Creed  is  as  follows :  "  We 
believe  in  one  God  the  Father  Almighty, 
Maker  of  all  things  both  visible  and  invisible; 
and  in  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ,  the  Son  of 
God,  begotten  of  the  Father,  only  begotten, 
that  is  to  say  of  the  substance  of  the  Father, 
God  of  God,  Light  of  Light,  very  God  of 
very  God,  begotten,  not  made,  being  of  the 
substance  with  the  Father,  by  whom  all 
things  were  made,  both  things  in  heaven 
and  things  in  earth ;  who  for  us  men  and 
for  our  salvation  came  down  and  was  made 
flesh,  and  was  made  man,  suffered,  and  rose 
again  on  the  third  day,  and  went  up  into  the 


CREED,  NIOENE 

heavens,  and  is  to  come  again  to  judge  the- 
quick  and  the  dead. — And  in  the  Holy 
Ghost." 

"  But  those  that  say,  '  there  was  when  He 
was  not,'  and  '  before  He  was  begotten  He 
was  not,'  and  that '  He  came  into  existence 
from  what  was  not,'  or  who  profess  that  the 
Son  of  God  is  of  a  different  'person'  or 
'  substance '  {erepas  {moardo-eas  ^  ova-mi), 
or  that  He  is  created,  or  changeable,  or 
variable,  by  the  Cathohc  Church  are  an- 
athematized." (Stanley's  Eastern  Churchy 
p.  140.) 

The  concluding  clauses  as  we  have  them 
(with  the  exception  of  "  from  the  Son  ")  are 
generally  supposed  to  have  been  added  to  the 
Creed  at  the  second  general  Council  at  Con- 
stantinople, when  the  heresy  of  Macedonius 
with  regard  to  the  Divinity  of  the  Holy  Ghost 
was  condemned.  (Bingham,  bk.  x.  4.)  But 
there  seemed  some  uncertainty  as  to  the 
matter:  for  Socrates,  Sozomen,  and  Theo- 
doret,the  historians  of  the  time,  make  men- 
tion of  the  Evangelic  faith  ratified  at  Niciea 
being  adhered  to  at  Constantinople,  but  not 
of  any  creed  or  symbol  being  set  forth  then. 
The  words  are  used  by  Epiphanius  (^Anchorat. 
n.  120,  t.  ii.  p.  120),  seven  years  before  the 
Council  of  Constantinople,  which  shows  that 
the  additional  clauses  were  not  prepared  by 
the  150  Fathers,  though  sanctioned  by  them. 
(See  Constantinople,  Councils  of.)  At  the 
Council  of  Chalcedon,  when  the  Nicene 
symbol  was  recited,  all  the  bishops  exclaimed, 
"  This  is  the  faith  of  the  orthodox.  We  all 
thus  believe."  The  Exposition  of  the  Con- 
stantinopolitan Fathers  was  then  read,  but 
not  amid  the  same  enthusiasm ;  from  which 
it  may  he  inferred  that  that  of  Nicsea  was 
regarded  by  the  bishops  as  the  symbol  of 
faith— the  additions  of  Constantinople  as  a. 
profession  received  among  the  Churches  in 
that  patriarchate.  (Dr.  Lumby,  8.  P.  C.  K. 
Prayer  Book,  p.  64  seq.)  The  enlarged  form 
was  probably  used  when  the  Creed  was  re- 
peated in  every  Church  Assembly.  The 
first  who  ordered  this  to  be  done  was  Peter 
Fullo,  bishop  of  Antioch,  in  471 ;  and  a 
similar  order  was  made  for  Constantinople 
by  Timotheus,  the  bishop  in  511.  (Theodor. 
Lector.  Hist.  lib.  ii.  pp.  563,  566.)  In  540 
it  had  become  the  generally  accepted  form,  as 
may  be  gathered  from  a  letter  (X.V.)  of  Pope 
Vigilius  of  that  date.  In  589  a  council  was 
summoned  by  Eecared,  king  of  the  Goths, 
at  Toledo,  against  Arianism ;  when  the  king, 
speaking  of  belief  in  the  Holy  Ghost,  used 
the  words  "  He  proceedeth  from  the  Father, 
and  from  the  Son."  One  of  the  canons 
runs,  "Quicunque  Spiritum  Sanctum  non 
crediderit,  a  Patre  el  Filio  procedere,  an- 
athema sit."  These  words  were  gradually 
adopted  by  the  other  Churches  of  the  West, 
but   never  by  the  Eastern  Church.     (See 


CREED,  NICENE 

Filioque.)  The  objections  were,  (1)  that 
the  words  went  beyond  Scripture  ;  (2)  that 
they  had  never  been  sanctioned  by  a  general 
council.  In  809  a  council  was  summoned  by 
Charles  the  Great  at  Aquis-Grani,  or  Aachen 
(Aix-la-Chapelle),  for  the  purpose  of  discus- 
sing this  "double  Procession."  The  opinion 
was  in  favour  of  the  addition  ;  but  Pope 
Leo  III.  would  not  sanction  the  interpolation, 
and  caused  a  copy  of  the  Creed,  without 
"  Filioque,"  to  be  engraved  on  silver  plates, 
and  set  up  in  St.  Peter's.  It  was,  however, 
afterwards  accepted  by  the  Roman  Church ; 
and  became  one  of  the  abiding  causes  of  the 
great  schism  between  the  Eastern  and 
Western  Churches. 

From  the  time  of  Peter  Fullo  (a.d.  471) 
to  the  present  day,  the  Creed  has  been  recited 
after  the  Gospel  in  the  Communion  office. 

"  The  Creed  is  a  summary  of  the  doctrine 
of  the  Gospel,  and  here  is  placed  next  to  it, 
because  it  is  grounded  upon  it.  In  the 
Gospel  we  'believe  with  our  heart  unto 
righteousness ; '  in  the  Creed  we  '  confess 
■with  our  mouth  unto  salvation'  (Rom.  x. 
10) ;  for  all  the  people  ought  to  repeat  the 
Creed  after  the  minister.  It  doth  more 
largely  condemn  all  heresies  than  the  Apos- 
tles' Creed  ;  wherefore  it  is  fitly  enjoined  to 
be  recited  by  all  before  the  Sacrament,  to 
show  that  all  the  communicants  are  free 
from  heresy,  and  in  the  strictest  league  of 
union  with  the  Cathohc  Church ;  as  also 
to  prepare  themselves  for  worthy  receiv- 
ing, by  exercising  that  faith  of  which  they 
have  so  much  use  at  the  Lord's  table,  as 
the  Council  of  Toledo  ordained  in  the  year 
600  [589].  So  that  every  one  must  openly 
profess  and  firmly  embrace  all  these  articles, 
Ijefore  he  can  be  fit  to  receive ;  yea,  and 
while  he  repeats  them  with  his  lips,  he 
must  resolve  to  show  forth  in  his  life, 
that  he  doth  sincerely  believe  them,  by 
strictly  living  according  to  them." — Bean 
Cornier. 

"  What  more  glorious  hymn  than  this 
can  we  sing  to  the  honour  of  God?  Is  it 
possible  to  mention  anything  else  that  can 
so  much  redound  to  His  gloiy  ?  May  not 
this  our  service  be  well  styled  the  Eucha- 
rist, when  we  thus  give  praise  and  glory 
to  Almighty  God  for  the  wonderful  mani- 
festation of  His  attributes,  and  the  inesti- 
mable blessings  He  hath  bestowed  upon  us  ? 
Let  not  any  one  therefore  think,  that  repeat- 
ing the  Creed  is  barely  a  declaration  of  his 
faith  to  the  rest  of  the  congregation :  for, 
besides  that,  it  is  a  most  solemn  act  of  wor- 
ship, in  which  we  honour  and  magnify  God, 
both  for  what  He  is  in  Himself,  and  for  what 
He  hath  done  for  us.  And  let  us  all,  sensible 
of  this,  repeat  it  with  reverential  voice  and 
gesture ;  and  lift  up  our  hearts  with  faith, 
thankfulness,  and  humble  devotion,  when- 


CREED 


267 


ever  we  say,  'I  believe,'  &c." — Archdeacon 
Tardley. 

Tho  Nicene  Creed  is  properly  sung  in  all 
choirs.  Bishop  Beveridge  says,  "  We  stand 
at  the  Creeds  ;  for  they  being  confessions  of 
our  faith  in  God,  as  such  they  come  under 
the  proper  notion  of  hymns  or  songs  of  praise 
to  Him."  The  rubric  sanctions — that  is, 
enjoins  in  choirs — the  custom :  and  such  has 
been  the  usage  of  most  choirs  since  the 
Reformation  ;  an  usage  kept  up  throughout 
the  Western  Church,  according  to  Mr.  Palmer, 
since  the  year  1012.  (Orig.  Liturg.  ir. 
iv.  p.  53.)  It  is  not  adapted  to  chanting, 
like  the  Psalms.  In  our  Prayer  Book  it  is 
divided,  like  the  Apostles'  Creed  and  the 
Gloria  in  excelsis,  into  three  paragraphs,  of 
which  the  central  one  has  special  reference 
to  God  the  Son.     [H.] 

CREED  OF  POPE  PIUS  IV.  A  suc- 
cinct and  explicit  summary  of  the  doctrine 
contained  in  the  canons  of  the  Council  of 
Trent,  is  expressed  in  the  creed  which  was 
published  by  Pius  IV.  in  1564,  in  the  form 
of  a  bull,  and  which  usually  bears  his  name. 
It  is  received  throughout  the  whole  Roman 
Catholic  Church ;  every  pereon  who  is  ad- 
mitted into  the  Roman  Church  publicly 
reads  and  professes  his  assent  to  it. 

The  "Symbol  of  Faith,"  our  Catholic 
creed,  is  first  recited,  but  to  it  additions  are 
made  which  cannot  be  called  Catholic,  such 
as — "  I  most  firmly  admit  and  embrace 
apostolical  and  ecclesiastical  traditions,  and 
all  other  constitutions  and  observances  of 
the  Church  of  Rome ; "  "  Seven  Sacraments, 
really  and  truly ; "  "  the  ceremonies  of  the 
Catholic  Church,  in  regard  to  these  sacra- 
ments ; "  "  all  the  definitions  declared  in  the 
Council  of  Trent  concerning  original  sin  and 
justification ; "  "  transubstantiation  —  the 
conversion  of  the  whole  substance  of  the 
bread  into  the  Body,  and  of  the  wine  into 
the  Blood ; "  "  Christ  received  under  either 
kind  alone ; "  "  purgatory  ;  "  "  invocation  of 
saints ;  "  "  veneration  to  images ; "  "  power 
of  the  Church  to  grant  indulgences."  The 
profession  goes  on  : — 

"I  acknowledge  the  holy  Catholic  and 
Apostolic  Roman  Church,  the  mother  and 
mistress  of  all  Churches ;  and  I  promise 
and  swear  true  obedience  to  the  Roman 
bishop,  the  successor  of  St.  Peter,  prince  of 
the  apostles,  and  vicar  of  Jesus  Christ. 

"  I  also  profess  and  undoubtedly  receive 
all  other  things  delivered,  defined,  and  de- 
clared by  the  sacred  canons  and  general 
councils,  and  particularly  by  the  holy 
Council  of  Trent ;  and  likewise  I  also  con- 
demn, reject,  and  anathematize  all  things  con- 
trary thereto,and  all  heresies  whatsoever  con- 
demned and  anathematized  by  the  Church. 

"  This  true  Catholic  faith,  out  of  which 
none  can  be   saved,   which   I  now   freely 


268 


CEESSELLE 


profess  and  truly  hold,  I,  N.,  promise,  vow, 
and  sv7ear  most  constantly  to  hold  and 
profess  the  same,  whole  and  entire,  with 
■God's  assista,nce,  to  the  end  of  my  life. 
Amen." 

CRESSELLE.  An  instrument  of  wood, 
made  nse  of  in  the  Koman  Church  during 
Passion  week,  instead  of  hells,  to  give 
notice  of  Divine  service.  This  is  done  in 
imitation  of  the  primitive  Christians,  who, 
they  suppose,  made  use  of  such  an  instru- 
ment, before  the  invention  of  bells,  to  call 
their  brethren  secretly  to  prayers.  There 
are  mysteries  in  the  Cresselle.  It  repre- 
sents Christ  praying  on  the  cross,  and 
■calling  nations  to  His  preaching;  as  also 
His  humility,  &c. 

CREST.  (In  ecclesiastical  architecture.) 
An  ornamental  finish  at  the  top  of  a  screen, 
or  other  subordinate  feature. 

CRISPIN.  Martyr.  Born  at  Rome,  he 
with  his  twin-brother  Crispinian,  St.  Quentin 
and  others,  accompanied  St.  Denys  on  a 
mission  from  Rome  into  Gaul  in  the  third 
century.  He  and  his  brother  worked  at 
their  trade  of  shoemaking  to  support  them- 
selves ;  hence  they  have  always  been  con- 
sidered the  "  patron  saints  "  of  shoemakers. 
They  were  beheaded,  after  terrible  torture,  in 
A.D.  288.  In  the  old  Calendar  the  two 
brothers  were  commemorated  on  the  same 
day,  to  which  Shakespeare  seems  to  refer : 

•*  And  Crispin  Crisplan  shall  ne'er  go  by. 
But  we  in  it  shall  be  remembered." 

Henry  V.  Act  iv.  8.  3. 

St.  Crispin's  day  in  the  Calendar  is  the  21st 
of  October.    [H.] 

CROSI ER.  The  pastoral  staff  of  a  bishop, 
crooked  at  the  top  and  pointed  at  the  bottom, 
and  thus  symbolical  of  the  bishop's  functions 
in  that  part  of  the  church  where  under  Christ 
he  is  the  chief  shepherd.  The  meaning  of 
the  several  parts  is  aptly  described  in  the 
line,  "  Curva  trahit,  quos  virga  regit,  pars 
ultima  pungit,"  inscribed  on  the  staff  of  St. 
Saturninus  at  Toulouse. 

There  are  allusions  to  the  pastoral  staff  of 
bishops  in  Greek  ■writers  of  the  4th  century 
(Greg.  Naz.  Orai.  42),  and  Latin  writers  of 
the  5th.  (Letter  of  Pope  Celestine  in  Labbe, 
Cone,  ii.) 

The  common  notion  that  the  crosier  was 
a,  staff  surmounted  by  a  cross,  and  was 
therefore  distinct  from  the  ordinary  pastoral 
staif,  and  in  fact  the  distinguishing  mark  of 
the  archiepiscopal  office,  appears  to  be  in- 
correct. Crosier  is  derived  not  from  cross, 
but  like  cross  itself,  and  a  multitude  of 
other  words  (as  crook,  crutch,  crotchet, 
crochet,  croquet,  cricket),  from  a  root  "cruk" 
or  "  crok,"  whichnot  only  in  Teutonic  but  also 
in  Celtic  languages  is  found  in  all  words  into 
which  the  notion  of  crookedness  enters.  lu 
mediajval  Latin  crocea,  croda,  croceus   sig- 


CROSS 

nify  sometimes  a  hook,  as  well  as  a  crooked 
statf.     (See  Ducange ;  also  Professor  Skeat's 
Etymological  Dictionary,  and  the  references 
there  given,  es2)ecially  tide  line, 
"  Because  a  crosier  staff  is  best  for  such  a  croolced  time.") 

An  archbishop  is  of  course  entitled  to 
carry  a  pastoral  staff  or  crosier  as  bishop  of 
his  own  diocese,  but  as  primate  he  is  also 
entitled  to  have  a  staff  surmounted  by  a 
cross,  as  one   of  the  chief  insignia  of  his 
archiepiscopal  office.     It  is  noticeable  that 
in  some  very  early  representations  of  Gregory 
the  Great,  one  being  supposed  to  belong  to 
the  7th  century,  he  appears  holding  a  staff 
surmounted  by  a  cross.  (See  Marriott,  Vesti- 
arum  Christianum,  p.  237.)  [W.  R.  W.  S.] 
CROSS.    The  cross  was  the  instrument 
of  death  to  our  most  blessed  Lord    and 
Saviour,  and  it  has  been  considered  in  all 
ages  by  the  Church  as  the  most  appropriate 
emblem,  or  symbol,   of  the  Christian   re- 
ligion.   The  sign  of  the  cross  was  made 
in  the  primitive  Church  in   some  part  of 
almost  every  Christian  office.    The  Church 
of  England,  in  the  Constitutions  of  1603, 
has  a  long  canon  (the  30th)  on  this  subject, 
wherein  it  is  said :  "  The  Holy  Ghost,  by 
the  mouths  of  the  Apostles,  did  honour  the 
name  of  the  cross,  being  hateful  among  the 
Jews,  so  far  that,  under  it.  He  compre- 
hended not  only  Christ  crucified,  but  the 
force,  effects,  and  merits  of  His  death  and 
passion,  with  all  the  comforts,  fruits,  and 
promises  which  we  receive  or  expect  there- 
by.    Secondly,  the  honour  and  dignity  of 
the  name  of  the  cross  begat  a  reverent 
estimation  even  in  the  Apostles'  times,  for 
aught  that  is  known  to  the  contrary,  of  the 
sign    of  the   cross,  which   the   Christians 
shortly  after    used    in    all  their  actions ; 
thereby  making  an  outward  show  and  pro- 
fession, even  to  the  astonishment  of  the 
Jews,  that  they  were  not  ashamed  to  ac- 
knowledge Him  for  their  Lord  and  Saviour, 
who  died  for  them  upon  the  cross.     And 
this  sign  they  not  only  used  themselves, 
with  a  kind  of  glory,  when  they  met  with 
any  Jews,  but  signed  therewith  their  chil- 
dren, when  they  were  christened,  to  dedicate 
them  by  that  badge  to  His  service,  whose 
benefits  bestowed  upon  them  in    baptism 
the  name  of  the  cross  did  represent.     And 
this  use  of  the  sign  of  the  cross  was  held  in 
the  primitive  Church,  as  well  by  the  Greeks 
as  by  the  Latins,   with  one  consent,  and 
great  applause.     At  which  time,  if  any  had 
opposed  themselves  against  it,  they  would 
certainly  have  been  censured  as  enemies  of 
the  name  of  the  cross,  and  consequently  of 
Christ's  merits,  the  sign  whereof  they  could 
no    better    endure.      This    continual    and 
general  use   of  the   sign    of  the  cross  is 
evident  by  many  testimonies  of  the  ancient 


CROSS 

Fathers.  Thirdly,  it  must  be  confessed 
that  in  process  of  time  the  signof  the  cross 
was  greatly  abused  in  the  Church  of  Rome, 
especially  after  that  corruption  of  Popery 
had  once  possessed  it.  But  the  abuse  of  a 
thing  doth  not  take  away  the  lawful  use  of 
it.  Nay,  so  far  was  it  from  the  purpose  of 
the  Church  of  England  to  forsake  and  reject 
the  Churches  of  Italy,  France,  Spain,  Ger- 
many, or  any  such  like  Churches,  in  all 
things  that  they  held  and  practised,  that,  as 
Bishop  Jewel's  '  Apology  of  the  Church  of 
England '  confesseth,  it  doth  with  reverence 
retain  those  ceremonies  which  do  neither 
endamage  the  Church  of  Grod,  nor  offend  the 
minds  of  sober  men;  and  only  departed 
from  them  in  those  particular  points  where- 
in they  were  fallen,  both  from  themselves  in 
their  ancient  integrity,  and  from  the  apo- 
stolical Churches  which  were  their  first 
founders.  In  which  respect,  amongst  some 
other  very  ancient  ceremonies,  the  sign  of 
the  cross  in  baptism  hath  been  retained  in 
this  Church,  both  by  the  judgment  and 
practice  of  those  reverend  fathers  and  grave 
divines  in  the  days  of  King  Edward  VI.,  of 
whom  some  constantly  suffered  for  the  pro- 
fession of  the  truth ;  and  others,  being  exiled 
in  the  time  of  Queen  Mary,  did,  after  their 
return,  in  the  beginning  of  the  reign  of  our 
late  dread  sovereign,  continually  defend  and 
use  the  same." 

CROSS,  CREEPING  TO.  Before  the 
Reformation,  on  Good  Friday,  a  cross  was 
set  up  in  front  of  the  altar,  and  the  clergy 
and  people  prostrated  themselves  before  it. 
A  proclamation  dated  30  Hen.  VIII.  orders  : 
"  On  Good  Friday  it  shall  be  declared  howe 
creepynge  of  the  crosse  signif3'eth  an 
humblynge  of  ourselfe  to  Christe  before 
the  crosse,  and  the  kissinge  of  it  as  a 
memorie  of  our  redemption  made  upon  the 
crosse."  While  the  prostration  went  on 
before  the  cross,  the  "  reproaches "  were 
sung;  and  during  the  ceremony  the  altar  was 
draped  in  black.     (See  Bep-oaches.)     [H.] 

CROSS,  INVENTION  OF.  The  legend 
is  that  St.  Helena,  the  mother  of  Constantine 
the  Great,  was  directed  in  a  dream  to  search 
at  Jerusalem  for  the  cross  on  which  our 
Lord  was  crucified.  Hadrian  had  en- 
deavoured to  obliterate  every  trace  of  the 
holy  sepulchre,  had  raised  the  ground  above 
the  spot,  and  built  thereon  temples  to 
Jupiter  and  Venus  {Patrol,  xx.  321).  Con- 
stantine determined  to  do  away  with  the 
abominations,  and  build  in  their  place  a 
temple  to  the  true  God.  (Buseb.  Vita  Const. 
iii.  26 ;  Soorat.  i.  17.)  In  view  of  this,  led 
by  her  dream,  Helena  caused  Mount  Calvary 
to  be  excavated.  She  was  rewarded  by 
finding  the  sepulchre  and  three  crosses  near 
it,  with  the  superscription  which  Pilate  had 
■written  hard  by,  but  not  attached  to  a  cross. 


CEUSADE 


26i) 


The  question  was,  which  was  the  true  cross 
To  solve  the  difficulty  Macarius,  bishop  of 
Jerusalem,  ordered  that  the  three  should  be 
separately  applied  to  a  sick  lady,  and  the  effect 
\ratched.  At  the  touch  of  the  third  the  sick 
lady  recovered,  and  therefore  it  was  naturally 
supposed  that  that  was  the  true  cross.  One 
part  was  set  in  silver  and  committed  to 
Macarius  to  be  preserved  at  Jerusalem,  and' 
the  remainder  was  sent  to  Constantine.  The 
nails  were  still  in  the  cross,  and  one  was  after- 
wards attached  to  the  emperor's  helmet, 
another  to  the  bridle  of  his  horse.  Socrates, 
Sozomen,  and  Theodoret  give  details  of  thift 
legend,  together  with  other  early  writers. 
(^Patrol,  xvi.,  xxi.,  Ixi.  &c.)  Paulinus,  writ- 
ing in  the  early  part  of  the  fifth  century,, 
tells  us  that  the  cross  "  very  kindly  afforded 
to  man's  importunate  desires,  wood,  without 
any  lo.'ss  of  its  substance."  {Ep.  ad  Severum,. 
31.)  According  to  St.  Ambrose's  account, 
Pilate's  inscription  was  found  fastened  on  the 
cross,  but  if  this  was  the  case  the  miracle 
with  regard  to  the  sick  lady  mentioned  above 
would  not  have  been  necessary.  (Ambrose,  de- 
ohitu  Theod.  c.  46.)  It  is  not  clear  when  the 
"  Invention  of  the  Cross  "  was  first  observed 
as  a  holy  day,  but  it  is  supposed  to  have 
been  instituted  by  Pope  Sylvester  I.  about 
330.  There  are  offices  for  the  day  in  the 
Sacramentaries  of  Gelasius  and  Gregory,  in 
which  it  is  marked  for  the  3rd  of  May,  on 
which  day  also  it  is  observed  in  our 
Calendar.     [H.] 

CRUCIFIX.  A  cross  upon  which  a 
sculptured  or  carved  image  of  the  body  of 
our  Lord  is  fastened.  It  is  much  used 
by  the  Romanists  and  the  Lutheran  Pro- 
testants, but  prohibited  in  the  Church  of 
England  since  the  Reformation,  on  tho 
ground  of  its  having  been  abused  to  super- 
stition and  idolatry. 

The  attempts  that  have  been  made  to- 
revive  it  liave  been  condemned  as  illegal, 
though  not  so  when  it  only  forms  one  of' 
the  group  of  images  representing  the  whole 
crucifixion,  as  in  the  Exeter  Reredos  case, 
6  P.  C.  449,  and  Hughes  v.  Edwards^ 
2  Prob.  Div.  361,  where  a  sculptured  tablet 
of  the  whole  crucifixion  was  allowed.  In 
Ridsdale  v.  Clifton,  2  Prob.  Div.  304,  P.  C. 
again  condemned  a  crucifix.    [G.] 

CRUSADE.  A  name  given  to  the 
Christian  expeditions  against  the  Infidels, 
for  the  recovery  of  the  Holy  Land  out  of 
their  hands,  because  they  who  engaged 
themselves  in  the  undertaking  wore  a  cross 
on  their  clothes,  and  had  one  on  their 
standards.  There  were  eight  crusades : 
the  first,  in  1096,  at  the  solicitation  of 
the  Greek  emperor  and  patriarch  of  Jeru- 
salem. Peter  the  Hermit,  who  was  the 
preacher  of  this  crusade,  was  made  general 
of  a  great  army,  a  thing  that  did  not  very- 


270 


CEUSADE 


■well  agree  with  his  profession,  being  a 
priest;  and  all  the  princes— Hugo  the 
Great,  count  of  Vermandois,  brother  to 
Philip  I.,  king  of  France;  Eobert,  duke  of 
Normandy;  Bobert,  count  of  Flanders; 
Eaymond,  count  of  Toulouse  and  St.  Giles ; 
Godfrey  of  Bouillon,  duke  of  Lorraine, 
with  his  brothers,  Baldwin  and  Eustace; 
Stephen,  count  of  Chartres  and  Blois; 
Hucro,  count  of  St.  Taul,  with  a  great 
number  of  other  lords— took  different  ways 
to  meet  at  Constantinople.  The  first  who 
inarched  his  troops  was  the  famous  God- 
frey de  Bouillon,  who  had  a  greater  share 
than  any  of  the  rest  in  this  undertaking, 
thouo-h  not  the  command  of  the  whole 
army.  He  commenced  his  march  Aug.  15, 
1096,  with  10,000  horse  and  70,000  foot; 
and  before  the  other  princes  were  come  to 
Constantinople,  passing  the  Hellespont, 
he  besieged  Nicaja,  which,  notwithstanding 
the  double-dealing  of  the  Greek  emperor 
Alexius,  after  six  weeks'  siege  was  surren- 
dered to  him;  after  which  he  victoriously 
entered  Syria  and  took  Antioch.  Jeru- 
salem was  taken  in  1099,  and  Gtjdfrey  of 
Bouillon  chosen  king;  a  httle  after  which 
the  Christians  gained  the  famous  battle  of 
Asoalon  against  the  Sidtan  of  Egyiit,  which 
■victory  put  an  end  to  the  first  crusade; 
for  the  princes  and  lords,  with  those  who 
followed  them,  liclicving  they  had  fully  ac- 
comphshed  the  vow  they  had  made,  took 
their  leave  of  Godfrey,  and  returned  to 
their  respootivo  countries. 

The  second  crusade  was  in  1145,  and 
this  was  headed  by  the  Emperor  Conrad  III. 
and  Louis  VII.  of  France:  the  emperor's 
army  was  either  destroyed  by  the  enemy, 
or  perished  through  the  treachery  of  the 
G-reek  emperor  Manuel  and  his  brother-in- 
law  ;  and  the  second  army,  through  the  un- 
faithfulness and  treachery  of  the  Christians 
of  Syria,  was  forced  to  quit  the  siege  of 
Damascus,  1148. 

The  third  crusade  was  in  1188,  after  the 
taking  of  Jerusalem  by  Saladin,  sultan 
of  E^ypt.  The  most  distinguished  per- 
sons engaged  in  this  expedition  were  the 
Emperor  Frederick  Barbarossa ;  Frederick, 
duke  of  Swabia,  his  second  son;  Leopold, 
duke  of  Austria;  Berthold,  duke  of  Mo- 
ravia ;  Herman,  marquis  of  Baden ;  the 
counts  of  Nassau,  Thuringen,  Meissen,  and 
Holland,  and  above  sixty  more  of  the 
chief  princes  of  the  empire,  with  divers 
bishops.  Barbarossa,  in  spite  of  the  Em- 
peror of  Coustautinople,  having  got  into 
Asia  Minor,  defeated  the  sultan  at  Ico- 
iiium,  but,  drawing  near  to  Syria,  sickened 
and  died  in  1190;  however,  his  son  Fre- 
derick led  the  army  to  Antioch,  and  joined 
with  Guy,  king  of  Jerusalem,  in  the  siege 
of  Ptolemais,"but,   failing  of  success,   he 


CEUSADE 

died  soon  after,  which  proved  the  ruin  of 
his  army.  Nevertheless,  Eichard,  king 
of  England,  and  Philip  Augustus,  king  of 
France,  arriving  some  months  after  in  the 
Holy  Land,  with  a  great  force,  compelled 
Ptolemais  to  surrender,  July  12,  1191. 
After  which,  Philip  retui-ned  home  in  dis- 
content, while  the  brave  King  Eichard 
concluded  a  peace  with  Saladin,  upon  these 
conditions — that  all  the  coast  from  Joppa 
to  Tyre  should  be  left  to  the  Christians, 
and  that  Saladin  should  have  all  the  rest 
of  Palestine  except  Ascalon,  which  was  to 
belong  to  the  party  who,  at  the  end  of  the 
truce,  obtained  possession  of  it;  and  that, 
during  the  truce,  which  was  to  last  three 
years,  three  months,  three  weeks,  and  three 
days,  it  should  be  lawful  for  the  Christians 
to  go  to  Jerusalem  in  small  companies  to 
pay  their  devotions  there. 

The  fourth  was  undertaken  in  1195,  by 
the  Emperor  Henry  VI.,  after  Saladin's 
death ;  his  army  started  for  the  Holy  Land 
three  several  ways,  and,  he  himself  at 
length  arriving  at  Ptolemais,  the  Chris- 
tians gained  several  battles  against  the 
Infidels,  and  took  many  towns;  but  the 
death  of  the  emperor  compelled  them  to 
quit  the  Holy  Land,  and  return  into  Ger- 
man}'. 

The  fifth  crusade  was  published  by  the 
artifice  of  Pope  Innocent  III.  in  1198. 
Most  of  the  adventurers  in  this  expedition 
employed  themselves  in  taking  Zara  for 
the  Venetians,  and  afterwards  in  making 
war  against  the  Greek  emperor,  or  rather 
usurper,  Alexius  Comnenus.  Constanti- 
nople was  taken  in  1203  by  Baldwin,  cormt 
of  Flanders,  who  was  elected  emperor  in 
1204.  Those  who  proceeded  to  Palestine 
suffered  a  defeat  in  the  same  year. 

The  sixth  crusade  began  in  1217,  in 
which  the  Christians  took  the  town  of  Da- 
mietta  in  1218,  but  were  forced  to  surrender 
it  again.  The  Emperor  Frederick  II.,  in 
1228,  went  to  the  Holy  Land,  and  next  year 
made  a  peace  with  the  sultan  for  ten  years, 
upon  these  conditions — that  the  sultan 
should  deliver  to  the  Christians  the  towns 
of  Jerusalem,  Bethlehem,  Nazareth,  Tyre 
and  Sidon,  but  the  Temple  of  Jerusalem 
should  be  left  to  the  Saracens,  to  perform 
the  free  exercise  of  their  law;  after  which 
the  emperor  returned  home.  About  1240, 
Eichard,  earl  of  Cornwall,  and  brother  to 
Henry  III.,  king  of  England,  arrived  in 
Palestine,  but,  finding  all  efibrts  useless 
while  the  Templars  and  Hospitallers  con- 
tinued their  disputes  and  private  animosi- 
ties, he,  with  the  advice  of  the  Duke  of 
Burgundy,  the  great  master  of  the  Hospital- 
lers, and  other  chief  persons  of  the  crusade, 
accepted  the  advantageous  conditions  the 
sultan  oifered,  whereby  the  Christians  were 


CRYPT 

•to  enjoy  some  lands  in  Palestine,  then  in 
ithe  soldan's  possession.  In  1244,  the  Co- 
rasmins,  the  descendants  of  the  ancient 
Parthians,  fell  upon  the  Christians  in  Pa- 
lestine, and  almost  extirpated  them. 

The  seventh  crusade  was  led  by  St. 
Louis,  king  of  Prance,  who  appeared  be- 
fore Damietta,  after  the  feast  of  Whitsun- 
tide in  1249.  He  took  it,  but  after  some 
battles  his  army  was  at  last  defeated,  and 
himself  taken  prisoner ;  after  which  a  truce 
was  concluded  for  ten  years,  and  the  Chris- 
tians were  to  keep  what  they  were  in  pos- 
session of,  except  Damietta,  which  was  to 
be  delivered  to  the  sultan  for  the  king's 
ransom,  with  a  great  sum  of  money ;  this 
•done,  the  king  sailed  for  Syria,  and  having 
put  Acre  and  other  seaports  in  a  good 
condition,  returned  home  in  1253. 

The  same  prince  put  himself  at  the  head 
of  the  eighth  crusade  in  1270,  and  laying 
siege  to  Tunis  without  success,  died  there ; 
but  his  son,  Philip  the  Bold,  and  Charles, 
king  of  Sicily,  afterwards  brought  the  king 
■of  Tunis  to  agree  to  a  truce  for  ten  years, 
upon  condition  that  he  should  set  all  the 
■slaves  of  his  kingdom  at  liberty ;  that  he 
should  give  the  Dominican  and  Franciscan 
friars  leave  to  preach  the  Gospel  in  his 
territories,  and  build  monasteries,  and  bap- 
tize all  those  who  should  desire  it,  besides  a 
sum  of  money  to  be  paid  to  Charles  yearly. 
About  this  time.  Prince  Edward  of  England 
.arrived  at  Ptolemais  with  a  small  force  of 
300  men.  He  hindered  Bendocdar  from 
laying  siege  to  Ptolemais,  but  was  obliged 
-soon  after  to  quit  the  Holy  Land  on  ac- 
■count  of  his  father's  death,  and  his  conse- 
quent succession  to  the  crown  of  England. 
In  1291  the  town  of  Ptolemais,  or  Acre, 
was  taken,  and  the  Christians  were  driven 
•out  of  Syria.  Since  which  time  there  has 
been  no  crusade,  though  the  Popes  have 
more  than  once  attempted  to  stir  up  Chris- 
tians to  the  undertaking. 

CEYPT.  The  subterranean  vault  under 
any  portion  of  a  church.  The  original  use 
of  the  crypt  seems  to  have  been  to  increase 
the  number  of  places  for  altars ;  they  were 
also  sometimes  used  as  places  of  burial, 
not  as  being  set  apart  for  that  purpose, 
but  that  persons  would  desire  to  be  buried 
"before  this  or  that  altar,  or  in  some  par- 
ticular place  in  the  crypt,  as  they  chose 
any  part  of  the  church  for  the  same 
purpose. 

The  crypt  is  generally  found  under  the 
east  end  of  the  church,  and  it  is  often  the 
•oldest  part  of  it,  and,  as  such,  full  of  in- 
terest to  the  student  of  ecclesiastical  archi- 
tecture and  antiquities.  It  often  contains 
evidence  of  the  form  and  extent  of  the 
•church  in  its  original  condition,  which 
-would  elsewhere  be   sought  in  vain.     The 


CULDEES 


271 


most  remarkable  crypts  in  England  are  those 
of  Canterbury,  Gloucester,  Worcester,  and 
Eochester.  A  t  Wrexham  and  Eipon  portions 
of  the  Saxon  remains  are  retained  in  the 
crypt,  and  at  York  the  size  and  form  of  the 
Norman  choir  is  displayed  in  the  older 
portion  of  the  crj'pt. 

CULDEES.  (Kelidei  or  Colidei.)  Many 
derivations  have  been  given  of  this  term, 
such  as  from  the  Gaelic  Kill,  "  a  cell,"  and 
dee  or  tee,  "a  house ; "  but  Braun  (Z)e  Culdees, 
1140)  and  Dr.  Beeves  (0»  the  Culdees,  1864) 
prove  the  origin  of  the  name  from  the 
Cele-de  (or  Irish  Ceile  De) — i.e.  "  servus 
Dei."  The  name  has  been  connected  with 
St.  Columba  and  his  mission  at  lona,  but 
there  seems  no  authority  for  this,  nor  are 
the  Culdees  named  by  Adamnan  in  his  Life  of 
that  saint,  though  it  ^pjjears  that  when  in  the 
ninth  century  the  ecclesiastical  supremacy 
of  lona  was  transferred  to  Dunkeld,  the 
latter  establishment  is  mentioned  as  be- 
longing to  the  Culdees.  About  the  latter 
part  of  the  eighth  century  the  name  was 
taken  by  a  very  ascetic  order  of  monks, 
established  by  Maelruain,  who  died  a.d. 
792,  at  Tallaght,  near  DubUn  (the  old 
name  being  Tamhlacht).  In  the  tenth 
and  eleventh  centuries,  the  Culdees  appear 
elsewhere  in  Ireland.  In  Scotland  the 
order  seems  to  have  been  introduced  shortly 
after  a.d.  800,  and  the  name  Colidei  occurs 
in  England  at  York  a.d.  936,  when  the 
officiating  clergy  of  the  Minster  were  thus 
styled. 

The  Colidei,  or  Culdees  in  general  (as 
appears  from  the  old  authorities  and  from 
Ware),  were  in  fact  the  ancient  colle- 
giate clergy  of  Ireland  and  Scotland,  in- 
cluding those  who  led  a  monastic  life — that 
is,  under  vows  of  celibacy;  yet  including 
communities  of  cathedral  canons,  who 
were  frequently  married,  though  living  to- 
gether near  their  cathedral,  with  an  abbot 
or  prior  at  their  head.  In  Scotland  the 
Culdees  constituted  the  chapter  of  several 
cathedrals,  and  elected  the  bishop,  as  Mr. 
Goodall  shows  from  charters  and  docu- 
ments still  extant.  At  St.  Andrew's  they 
were  the  sole  chapter  and  electors  of  the 
bishop  till  1140,  when  canons  regular  were 
introduced,  who  shared  the  privileges  of 
the  Culdees  till  1273.  Great  jealousy  sub- 
sisted between  these  ancient  communities 
and  the  interior  secular  canons  and  monks, 
who  in  the  course  of  time  expelled  or  su- 
perseded the  Culdees.  There  was  no  dif- 
ference of  doctrine  however  between  them ; 
for  the  Culdees,  though  originally  inde- 
pendent of  Rome,  adopted  Eoman  systems, 
like  the  other  clergy.  The  causes  of  dispute 
were  those  differences  in  discipline,  and 
those  jealousies  which  have  ever  prevailed 
among  rival  commxmities. 


272 


CUP 


They  held  to  what  they  thought  their 
rights,  and  iu  1297  opposed  the  election 
of  Lamberton  to  St.  Andrew's,  who  had 
been  appointed  by  the  canons;  but,  on 
appeal  to  the  Pope,  they  lost  their  case. 
It  was  then  said,  "omne  jus  deinceps 
Keldeis  abrogatum  est."  But  they  were 
not  finally  excluded  from  taking  part  in 
the  election  of  bishops  till  1332 ;  after 
which  their  name  never  occurs  in  records, 
being  changed  into  a  provostry,  under  the 
title  of  "  praspositum  ecclesise  beataj  Marias 
civitatis  Sancti  Andrese,"  which  after  the 
Reformation  was  vested  in  the  Crown. — 
Dr.  Beeves'  Culdees,  38 ;  Bp.  Eussell's  edi- 
tion of  Keith's  Scottish  Bisliops,  with 
Goodall's  Preliminary  Dissert. ;  Burton's 
Scotland,  ii.  p.  31 ;  Ussher,  de  Prim.  p.  659 ; 
Dr.  Beeves'  Dissertation  in  the  Proceedings 
of  the  Boyal  Irish  Academy,  1860 ;  Grub. 
Eccles.  Hist.  Scot.     [H.] 

CUP.  The  sacred  vessel  in  which  the 
consecrated  wine  in  the  Lord's  Supper  is 
conveyed  to  the  communicant,  distinguished 
from  the  flagon,  iu  which  the  wine  is 
brought  to  the  altar,  and  in  which,  if  more 
than  the  cup  will  conveniently  hold  is 
required,  it  is  consecrated.  The  rubric 
directs  that  it  shall  be  delivered  to  each 
communicant. 

Eubric.  "When  the  priest,  standing 
before  the  table,  hath  so  ordered  the  bread 
and  wine,  that  he  may  with  the  more  readi- 
ness and  decency  break  the  bread  before 
the  people,  and  take  the  cup  into  his  hands, 
he  shall  say  the  prayer  of  consecration,  as 
foUoweth."  And  in  the  prayer  of  conse- 
cration, "Here  he  is  to  take  the  cup  into 
his  hand,"  and  "  Here  to  lay  his  hand  upon 
every  vessel  (be  it  chalice  or  flagon)  in 
which  there  is  any  wine  to  be  consecrated." 

"The  minister  that  delivereth  the  cup 
to  any  shall  say,  The  Blood  of  our  Lord 
Jesus  Christ,"  &c. 

Article  30.  "  The  cup  of  the  Lord  is 
not  to  be  denied  to  the  lay  people;  for 
both  the  parts  of  the  Lord's  sacrament, 
by  Christ's  ordinance  and  commandment, 
ought  to  be  ministered  to  all  Christian  men 
alike." 

This  article  is  directed  against  the 
Eomish  custom  of  denying  the  cup  to  the 
laity,  concerning  which  it  may  be  enough 
to  say,  that  ii  is  clearly  and  confessedly 
contrary  to  the  custom  of  the  Church ; 
that  for  twelve  centuries  there  was  no  in- 
stance to  be  adduced  of  any  receiving  in 
one  kind  at  the  public  celebration  of  the 
Eucharist ;  and  that  it  was  even  accounted 
sacrilege  to  deprive  any  of  either  part  of 
our  blessed  Lord's  ordinance.  (Bingham, 
XV.  5,  and  xvi.  6-27  :  see  Communion  in 
one  Kind  ;  Fistula  ;  Mixed  Chalice.) 

It  appears  from  the  unanimous  testimony 


CUP 

of  the  Fathers,  and  from  all  the  ancient 
rituals  and  liturgies,  that  the  sacrament  of 
the  Lord's  Supper  was,  in  the  early  ages 
of  the  Church,  administered  in  both  kinds^ 
as  well  to  the  laity  as  to  the  clergy.  The 
practice  of  denying  the  cup  to  the  laity 
arose  out  of  the  doctrine  of  transubstan- 
tiation.  The  belief  that  the  sacramental 
bread  and  wine  were  actually  converted 
into  the  body  and  blood  of  Christ,  natu- 
rally produced,  in  a  weak  and  superstitious 
age,  an  anxious  fear  lest  any  part  of  them 
should  be  lost  or  wasted.  To  prevent 
anything  of  this  kind  in  the  bread,  small 
wafers  were  used,  which  were  put  at  once- 
into  the  mouths  of  the  commimicants  by 
the  ofiBciating  ministers;  but  no  expedient 
could  be  devised  to  guard  against  the- 
occasional  spilling  of  the  -wine  in  admin- 
istering it  to  large  congregations.  The 
bread  was  sopped  in  the  wine,  and  the- 
wine  was  conveyed  by  tubes  into  the- 
mouth,  but  all  in  vain ;  accidents  still 
happened,  and  therefore  it  was  determined 
that  the  priests  should  entirely  withhold 
the  cup  from  the  laity.  It  is  to  be  sup- 
posed that  a  change  of  this  sort,  in  so  im- 
portant an  ordinance  as  that  of  the  Lord's 
Supper,  could  not  be  effected  at  once.  The- 
first  attempt  seems  to  have  been  made  in 
the  twelfth  century  ;  it  was  gradually  sub- 
mitted to,  and  was  at  last  established  by 
the  authority  of  the  Council  of  Constance, 
in  the  year  1414 ;  but  in  their  decree  they 
acknowledged  that  "  Christ  did  institute 
this  sacrament  of  both  kinds,  and  that  the 
faithful  in  the  primitive  Church  did  receive 
both  kinds ;  yet  a  practice  being  reasonably 
introduced  to  avoid  some  dangers  and 
scandals,  they  appoint  the  custom  to  con- 
tinue of  consecrating  in  both  kinds,  and  of 
giving  to  the  laity  only  in  one  kind,"  thu& 
presuming  to  depart  from  the  positive 
commands  of  our  Lord  respecting  the- 
manner  of  administering  the  sign  of  the 
covenant  between  Himself  and  mankind. 
From  that  time  it  has  been  the  invariable 
practice  of  the  Church  of  Bome  to  confine 
the  cup  to  the  priests.  And  it  was  again 
admitted  at  the  Council  of  Trent,  that  th& 
Lord's  Supper  was  foi-merly  administered 
in  both  kinds  to  all  communicants,  but  it 
was  openly  contended  that  the  Church  had 
power  to  make  the  alteration,  and  that 
they  had  done  it  for  weighty  and  just 
causes.  These  causes  are  not  stated  in 
the  canon  of  the  council.  The  reformed 
Churches,  even  the  Lutheran,  which  main- 
tains the  doctrine  of  consubstantiation,  re- 
stored the  cup  to  the  laity.  In  a  convo- 
cation held  in  the  first  year  of  Edward  VI.'s 
reign,  it  was  unanimously  voted  that  the 
sacrament  of  the  Lord's  Supper  should 
be  received  in  both  kinds  by  the  laity  as 


CUEATE 

(veil  as  the  clergy ;  and  therefore  it  is 
remarkable  tliat  tliere  was  nothing  on  this 
subject  in  the  articles  of  1552 ;  both  this 
and  the  preceding  article  [29th]  were  added 
in  1562. — Bp.  Tomline. 

[It  was  decided  by  the  Privy  Council  in 
Elphinstone  v.  Purchas,  reversing  a  decision 
of  Sir  R.  PhiUimore,  that  it  is  unlawful  to 
mix  water  with  the  wine,  either  before  or 
at  the  time  of  Celebration.  The  contention 
that  the  wine  used  at  the  original  in- 
stitution, and  on  many  other  occasions 
referred  to  in  the  New  Testament,  was  not 
wine  in  the  common  sense,  but  unfermented 
grape-juice,  would  certainly  share  the  same 
fate.  Courts  of  Justice  do  not  allow  new 
meanings  to  be  given  to  well-understood 
words,  even  if  they  can  be  shown  to  be 
used  somewhere  else  in  such  new  sense,  or 
to  be  etymologically  or  otherwise  capable 
of  it:  not  that  the  word  "wine"  can  be 
argued  with  the  smallest  probability — or 
we  may  say,  honesty — to  be  ever  used  in 
the  Bible  for  unfermented  grape-juice].    [G.] 

CURATE.  The  person  who  has  the  cure 
of  souls  in  a  parish.  In  this  sense  the  word 
is  used  in  the  Prayer  Book,  "  aU  bishops  and 
curates,"  as  the  word  is  still  employed  in 
other  countries. 

But  with  us  the  word  is  generally  used 
to  denote  the  minister,  whether  presbyter  or 
deacon,  who  is  employed  under  the  spiritual 
rector  or  vicar,  as  assistant  to  him  in  the 
same  church,  or  else  in  a  chapel  ,of  ease 
within  the  same  parish,  belonging  to  the 
mother  church.  Where  there  is  in  a  parish 
neither  spiritual  rector  nor  vicar,  but  a  clerk 
/employed  to  officiate  there  by  the  impropria^ 
tor,  this  is  called  a  perpetual  curacy,  and  the 
priest  thus  employed  the  perpetual  curate. 
But  all  perpetual  curates  have  been  made 
vicars  by  31  &  32  Vict.  c.  11 7,  amending  a 
previous  Act  of  1868  partially  to  the  same 
effect,  at  least  of  churches  where  marriages 
may  be  performed,  which  is  practically  all 
district  churches.  The  appointment  of  a 
curate  to  officiate  under  an  incumbent,  in 
his  own  church,  mustbe  by  such  incumbent's 
nomination  of  him  to  the  bishop.  To  every 
one  of  these  several  kinds  of  curates,  the 
ordinary's  licence  is  necessary  before  he 
shall  be  admitted  to  officiate. 

For  by  Canon  41,  "  No  curate  or  minister 
shall  be  permitted  to  serve  in  any  place 
without  examination  and  admission  of  the 
bishop  of  the  diocese,  or  ordinary  of  the 
place  having  episcopal  jurisdiction,  under  his 
hand  and  seal,  having  respect  to  the  great- 
ness of  the  cure,  and  meetness  of  the  party." 

And  by  the  same  canon,  "  If  the  curates 
remove  from  one  diocese  to  another,  they 
shall  not  be  by  any  means  admitted  to 
serve  without  testimony  in  writing  of  the 
bishop  of  the   diocese,  or   ordinary  of  the 


CUEATE 


273 


place  having  episcopal  jurisdiction,  from 
whence  they  came,  of  their  honesty,  ability, 
and  conformity  to  the  ecclesiastical  laws  of 
the  Church  of  England." 

By  Canon  36,  "  No  person  shall  be  suf 
fered  to  preach,  to  catechize,  or  to  be  a 
lecturer,  in  any  parish  church,  chajiel,  or 
other  place,  except  he  be  licensed  either  by 
the  archbishop  or  by  the  bishop  of  the 
diocese,  and  except  he  shall  first  subscribe  to 
the  three  articles  specified  in  the  said  canon, 
concerning  the  king's  supremacy,  the  Book 
of  Common  Prayer,  and  the  Thirty-nine 
Articles  of  religion." 

But  that  is  modified  by  the  Clerical  Sub- 
scription Act,  1865,  and  curates  have  to 
declare  their  assent  to  the  Prayer  Book  and 
Articles,  but  not  to  read  the  Articles,  on  the 
first  Sunday  when  they  officiate  under 
licence.  It  has  been  held  that  this  and 
some  other  enactments  and  canons  do  not 
apply  to  persons  only  officiating  temporarily 
or  occasionally  for  an  incumbent. 

And  by  Canon  37,  "  None  who  hath  been 
licensed  to  preach,  read,  lecture,  or  catechize, 
and  shall  afterwards  come  to  reside  in 
another  diocese,  shall  be  permitted  there  to 
preach,  read,  lecture,  catechize,  or  ad- 
minister the  sacraments,  or  to  execute  any 
other  ecclesiastical  function,  by  what  au- 
thority soever  he  be  thereunto  admitted, 
unless  he  first  consent  and  subscribe  to  the 
three  articles  before  mentioned,  in  the 
presence  of  the  bishop  of  the  diocese 
wherein  he  is  to  preach,  read,  lecture, 
catechize,  or  administer  the  sacraments  as 
aforesaid." 

A  curate  not  licensed  may  be  removed 
at  pleasure ;  but,  if  licensed,  he  can  be  re- 
moved only  by  the  consent  of  the  bishop,  on 
six  months'  notice  from  the  incumbent; 
except  that  a  new  incumbent  may  dismiss 
the  old  curates  on  six  weelcs'  notice  at  any 
time  within  his  iirst  six  months,  by  1  &  2 
Vict.  c.  107,  s.  95.  And  by  s.  97  a  curate 
may  not  leave  without  giving  three  months' 
notice  to  the  incumbent  and  the  bishop,  on 
pain  of  forfeiting  six  months'  salary.  By 
s.  98  the  bishop  may  summarily  revoke  a 
curate's  licence  for  reasonable  cause,  subject 
to  appeal  to  the  archbishop,  but  none  further 
to  the  Privy  Council,  as  the  appeal  is  made 
to  the  archbishop  himself  and  not  his  court. 
The  curate  has  no  appeal  from  the 
bishop  merely  authorising  the  incumbent 
to  dismiss  him,  as  the  judgment  of  them 
both  has  concurred ;  but  if  he  refuses,  the 
incumbent,  if  resident,  or  wanting  to 
return,  may  appeal  (s.  95).  In  the  archi- 
episcopal  dioceses  there  can  be  no  such  ap- 
peal (See  Cliapel). 

By  the  76th  section  of  that  Act  it  is 
enacted  as  follows :  "  And  be  it  enacted, 
that  in   every  case  where  a  curate  is  ap- 

T 


274 


CURATE 


pointed  to  serve  in  any  benefice  upon 
whicli  the  incumbent  either  does  not  re- 
side, or  has  not  satisfied  the  bishop  of  his 
full  purpose  to  reside  during  four  months 
of  the  year,  such  curate  shall  be  required 
by  the  bishop  to  reside  within  the  parish 
or  place  in  which  such  benefice  is  situate, 
or  if  no  convenient  residence  can  be  pro- 
cured within  such  parish  or  place,  then 
within  three  statute  miles  of  the  church  or 
chapel  of  the  benefice  in  which  he  shall  bo 
licensed  to  serve,  except  in  cases  of  neces- 
sity, to  be  approved  of  by  the  bishop,  and 
specified  in  the  licence,  and  such  place  of 
residence  shall  also  be  specified  in  the 
licence." 

By  the  81st  section  of  the  same  Act  it  is 
enacted  as  follows :  "  And  be  it  enacted, 
that  every  bishop  to  whom  any  application 
shall  be  made  for  any  licence  for  a  curate 
to  serve  for  any  person  not  duly  residing 
upon  his  benefice,  shall,  before  he  shall 
grant  such  licence,  require  a  statement  of 
all  the  particulars  by  this  Act  required  to 
be  stated  by  any  person  applying  for  a 
licence  for  non-residence ;  and  in  every 
case  in  which  application  shall  be  made  to 
any  bishop  for  a  licence  for  any  stipendiary 
curate  to  serve  in  any  benefice,  whether 
the  incumbent  be  resident  or  non-resident, 
such  bishop  shall  also  require  a  declaration 
in  writing,  to  be  made  and  subscribed  by 
the  incumbent  and  the  curate,  to  the  pur- 
port and  effect  that  the  one  bona  fide  in- 
tends to  pay,  and  the  other  honci  fide  in- 
tends to  receive,  the  whole  actual  stipend 
mentioned  in  such  statement,  without  any 
abatement  in  respect  of  rent  or  consider- 
ation for  the  use  of  the  glebe  house,  and 
without  any  other  deduction  or  reservation 
whatever." 

By  the  83rd  section  of  the  same  Act  it  is 
enacted  as  follows :  "  And  be  it  enacted, 
that  it  shall  be  lawful  for  the  bishop  of 
the  diocese,  and  be  is  hereby  required, 
subject  to  the  several  provisions  and  re- 
strictions in  this  Act  contained,  to  appoint 
to  every  curate  of  a  non-resident  incum- 
bent such  stipend  as  is  specified  in  this 
Act ;  and  every  licence  to  be  granted  to  a 
stipendiary  curate,  whether  the  incumbent 
of  the  benefice  be  resident  or  non-resident 
thereon,  shall  specify  the  amount  of  the 
stipend  to  be  paid  to  the  curate ;  and  in 
case  any  difference  shall  arise  between  the 
incumbent  of  any  benefice  and  his  curate 
touching  such  stipend,  or  the  payment 
thereof,  or  of  the  arrears  thereof,  the 
bishop,  on  complaint  to  him  made,  may 
and  shall  summarily  hear  and  determine 
the  same,  without  appeal;  and  in  case  of 
wilful  neglect  or  refusal  to  pay  such  sti- 
pend, or  the  arrears  thereof,  he  is  hereby 
empowered  to    enforce    payment    of  such 


CUKATE 

stipend,  or  the  arrears  thereof,  by  moni- 
tion, and  by  sequestration  of  the  profits  of 
such  benefice." 

The  following  papers  are  to  be  sent  to 
the  bishop  by  a  curate  applying  to  be 
licensed :  — 

1.  A  nomination  by  the  incumbent. 

The  following  form  of  nomination  is  in- 
tended to  serve  where  the,  incumbent  is 
non-resident. 


"To  the  Eight  Eeverend- 
of 


-Lord  Bishop 


"  I,  Gr.  H.  of ,  in  the  county  of , 

and  your   lordship's    diocese   of  ,   da 

hereby  nominate  E.  F.,  bachelor  of  arts  (or 
other    degree),  to   perform   the   office  of  a 

curate   in   my   church   of aforesaid ; 

and  do  promise  to  allow  him  the  yearly- 
stipend  of ,  to  be  paid  by  equal  quar- 
terly payments,  [as  to  amount  of  stipend  see 
1  &  2  Vict,  c.  106,  and  the  latter  part  of  this 
article,]  with  the  surplice  fees,  amounting 

to  pounds  per  annum  (if  they  are  in~ 

tended  to  he  allowed),  and  the  use  of  the- 
glebe  house,  garden,  and  offices  which  he 
is  to  occupy  (if  that  he  the  fact ;  if  not, 
state  the  reason,  and  name  where  and  at 
what  distance  from  the  church  the  curate 
purposes  to  reside) :  and  I  do  hereby  state 
to  your  lordship,  that  the  said  E.  F.  does 
not  serve  any  other  parish,  as  incumbent 
or  ciirate ;  and  that  he  has  not  any  cathe- 
dral preferment  or  benefice,  and  does  not 
officiate  in  any  other  church  or  chapel  (if, 
however,  the  curate  does  serve  another  church 
as  incumbent,  or  as  curate,  or  has  any  cathe- 
dral preferment,  or  a  benefice,  or  officiates 
in  any  other  church  or  chapel,  the  same 
respectively  must  he  correctly  and  particu- 
larly stated) :  that  the  net  annual  value  of 
my  said  benefice,  estimated  according  to 
the  Act  1  &  2  Vict.  o.  106,  ss.  8  &  10, 
is ,  and  the  population  thereof,  accord- 
ing to  the  latest  returns  of  population 
made  under  the   authority  of  parliament, 

is ;    that    there    is  only  one  church 

belonging  to  my  said  benefice  (if  there  he 
another  church  or  chapel,  state  the  fact) ; 
and  that  I  was  admitted  to  the  said  benefice 
on  the day  of ,  18 — . 

Witness  my  hand  this  day  of 

,  in  the  year  of  our  Lord  one 

thousand  eight  hundred  and  . 


[Signature  and  address  of  J 


G.  H." 


Declaration  to  he  written  at  the  foot  of  the 
Nomination. 

"  We  the  before-named  G.  H.  and  E.  F. 
do  declare  to  the  said  Lord  Bishop  of , 


CURATE 

as  follows :  namely,  I  the  said  Q.  H.  do 
declare,  that  I  bond  fide  intend  to  pay,  and 
I  the  said  E.  F.  do  declare  that  I  hand  fide 
intend  to  receive,  the  whole  actual  stipend 
mentioned  in  the  foregoing  nomination  and 
statement,  without  any  abatement  in  re- 
spect of  rent,  or  consideration  for  the  use  of 
the  glebe  house,  garden,  and  offices,  thereby 
agreed  to  be  assigned,  and  without  any  other 
deduction  or  reservation  whatsoever. 

Witness  our  hands  this  day  of 

,  one  thousand  eight  hundred 

and . 

[Signatures  of  2       G.  H.  and  E.  F." 

The  following  fonn  of  nomination  is  pro- 
posed where  the  incumbent  is  resident. 

The  same  form  as  the  preceding,  so  far  as 
"  quarterly  payments  " ;  then  proceed  as  fol- 
lows :  "  And  I  do  hereby  state  to  your  lord- 
ship, that  the  said  E.  F.  intends  to  reside 
in  the  said  parish,  in  a  house  (describe  its 
situation  so  as  clearly  to  identify  it)  distant 

from  my  church mile  (if  E.  F.  does 

not  inte^id  to  reside  in  the  parish,  then  state 
at  what  place  he  intends  to  reside,  and  its 
aistance  from  the  said  church) ;  and  that 
the  said  E.  F.  does  not  serve  any  other 
parish  as  incumbent  or  curate ;  and  that 
he  has  not  any  cathedral  preferment  or 
benefice,  and  does  not  officiate  in  any  other 
church  or  chapel  (if,  however,  the  curate 
does  serve  another  parish,  as  incumbent  or 
as  curate,  or  has  any  cathedral  preferment 
or  a  benefice,  or  officiates  in  any  other  church 
or  chapel,  the  same  respectively  must  be  cor- 
rectly and  particularly  stated). 

Witness  my  hand  this day  of 

,  in  the  year  of  our  Lord  one 

thousand  eight  hundred  and . 

[Signature  and  address  of  2     G.  H." 

Declaration  to  he  written  at  the  foot  of  the 
Nomination. 

The  declaration  to  be  signed  by  the  in- 
cumbent and  curate  is  to  be  in  the  same 
form  as  that  given  above,  so  far  as  the 
word  "  statement " ;  after  which,  proceed 
as  follows :  "  Without  any  deduction  or 
reservation  whatsoever. 

Witness  cur  hands  this day  of 

,  one  thousand  eight  hundred 

and . 

[Signatures  of]      G.  H.  and.  E.  P." 

2.  Letters  of  orders,  deacon  and  priest. 

3.  Letters  testimonial  to  be  signed  by 
three  beneficed  clergymen,  in  the  following 
form: 

"  To  the  Et.  Rev, ,  Lord  Bishop  of — — 

"  We,  whose  names  are  hereunder  writ- 


CURATE 


275 


ten,  testify  and  make  known  that  A.  B. 
cleric,  bachelor   of  arts  (or   other  degree), 

of  college,  in  the  university  of , 

nominated  to   serve   the   cure   of ,  in 

the   county  of ,  hath  been  personally 

known  to  us  for  the  space  of*  three  years 
last  past;  that  we  have  had  opportunities 
of  observing  his  conduct ;  that  during  the 
whole  of  that  time  we  verily  believe  that 
he  lived  piously,  soberly,  and  honestly,  nor 
have  we  at  any  time  heard  anything  to  the 
contrary  thereof;  nor  hath  he  at  any  time, 
as  far  as  we  know  or  believe,  held,  written 
or  taught  anything  contrary  to  the  doctrine 
or  discipline  of  the  Church  of  England ; 
and,  moreover,  we  believe  him  in  our  con- 
sciences to  be,  as  to  his  moral  conduct,  a 
person  worthy  to  be  licensed  to  the  said 
curacy. 

In  witness  whereof  we  have  hereunto 

set  our  hands  this day  of , 

in  the  year  of  our  Lord  one  thou- 
sand eight  hundred  and . 

t  0.  D'.  rector  of . 

E.  F.  vicar  of . 

G.  H.  rector  of ." 

To  be  countersigned,  if  all  or  either  of 
the  subscribers  to  the  testimonial  are  not 
beneficed  in  the  diocese  of  the  bishop  to 
whom  it  is  addressed,  by  the  bishop  of  the 
diocese  wherein  their  benefices  are  re- 
spectively situate. 

On  receipt  of  these  papers,  the  bishop, 
if  he  be  satisfied  with  them,  will  either  ap- 
point the  clergyman  nominated  to  attend 
him,  to  be  licensed,  or  issue  a  commission 
to  some  neighbouring  incumbent. 

Before  the  licence  is  granted,  the  curate 
is  to  subscribe  the  Thirty-nine  Articles, 
and  the  three  articles  in  the  36th  canon ; 
to  declare  his  conformity  to  the  liturgy  of 
the  Church  of  England,  and  to  take  the 
oaths  of  allegiance  and  supremacy,  and  of 
canonical  obedience : — 

"  L  E.  F.,  do  swear  that  I  will  pay  true 
and  canonical  obedience  to  the  Lord  Bishop 

of in  all   things   lawful   and  honest. 

So  help  me  God." 

The  licence  will  be  sent  by  the  bishop 
to  the  registry-office,  and  from  thence  it 
will  be  forwarded  to  the  churchwardens. 

Within  three  months  after  he  is  licensed, 
the  curate  is  to  read  in  the  church  the 
declaration  appointed  by  the  Act  of  Uni- 
foimity,  and  also  the  certificate  of  his 
having  subscribed  it  before  the  bishop. 

•  If  the  clerk  nominated  ahall  have  been  ordained  a 
less  time  than  three  years,  the  testimonial  may  be  frum 
the  time  of  ordination. 

f  It  is  recommended  that  the  clergyman  nominating 
be  not  a  Bubscriber  to  the  testimonial. 

T  2 


276 


CURATE 


By  the  lOGth  section  of  the  Eesidence 
Act  (1  &  2  Vict.  0.  lOG),  it  is  enacted  that 
no  S])iritual  person  shall  serve  more  than 
two  benefices  in  one  day,  unless  in  case  of 
unforeseen  and  pressing  emeigency,  in  which 
case  he  shall  forthwith  report  the  circum- 
stance to  the  bishop. 

The  directions  as  to  notices  to  be  given 
for  the  curate  to  give  up  the  cure,  are  con- 
tained in  the  95th  section  of  the  said  Act, 
and  for  his  quitting  the  house  of  residence 
in  the  96th  section;  and  as  to  notice  of  the 
curate's  intention  to  relinquish  the  cure,  in 
the  97th  section ;  and  power  is  given  to 
the  bishop,  by  the  98th  section,  to  revoke 
any  licence  to  a  curate  (after  having  given 
him  sufficient  opportunity  to  show  reason 
to  the  contrary),  subject  to  an  appeal  to 
the  archbishop  of  the  province  within  one 
month  after  service  of  revocation. 

(1.)  FoEM  of  notice  by  a  new  incunibent  to 
a  curate  to  quit  curacy,  or  to  give  up 
possession  of  house  of  residence. 

"I,  A.  B.,  clerk,  having  been  duly  ad- 
mitted to  the  rectory  of ,  in  the  county 

of ,  and  diocese  of ,  do  hereby,  in 

pursuance  of  the  power  and  authority  for 
this  purpose  vested  in  me  by  virtue  of  the 
Act  of  Parliament  passed  in  the  first  and 
second  years  of  her  present  Majesty's  reign, 
intituled  '  An  Act  to  abridge  the  holding 
of  benefices  in  plurality,  and  to  make 
better  provision  for  the  residence  of  the 
clergy,'  give  notice  to  and  require  you, 
C.  I).,  clerk,  to  quit  and  give  up  the  curacy 

of aforesaid  [the  following  to  he  added 

where  applicable,  and  to  deliver  up  posses- 
sion of  the  rectory  house  of aforesaid, 

and  the  offices,  stables,  gardens,  and  ap- 
purtenances thereto  belonging,  and  (if  any) 
such  part  of  the  glebe  land  as  has  been 
assigned  to  you]  at  the  expiration  of  six 
weeks  from  the  giving  of  this  notice  to 
you. 

Witness  my  hand  this day  of 

,  one  thousand  eight  hundred 

and ." 

(2.)  Form  of  notice  by  an  incumbent, 
•with  consent  of  the  bishop,  to  a  curate 
to  quit  curacy,  or  to  give  up  house  of 
residence. 

"  I,  A.  B.,  clerk,  rector  of ,  in  the 

county   of ,    and  diocese  of ,   in 

pursuance  of  the  power  and  authority  for 
this  purpose  vested  in  me  by  virtue  of  the 
Act  of  Parliament  passed  in  the  first  and 
second  years  of  her  present  Majesty's  reign, 
intituled  '  An  Act  to  abridge  the  holding 
of  benefices  in  plurality,  and  to  make 
better  provision  for  the  residence  of  the 
clergy,'  do  hereby,  with  the  permission  of 
the  Eight   Reverend Lord  Bishop  of 


CUEATE 

the  diocese  of aforesaid,  signified  by 

writing  under  his  lordship's  hand,  give 
notice  te,  and  require  you,  0.  D.,  clerk,  my 

licensed   curate  of  aforesaid,  to  quit 

and  give  up  the  said  curacy  of  [the 

following  to  he  added  where  applicable,  and 

the   rectory  house   of  aforesaid,  and 

the  offices,  stables,  gardens,  and  appur- 
tenances thereto  belonging,  and  (if  any) 
such  part  of  the  glebe  land  as  has  been 
assigned  to  you]  at  the  expiration  of  six 
calendar  months  from  the  giving  of  this 
notice  to  you.* 

AVitness  my  hand  this day  of 

,  one  thousand  eight  hundred 

and ." 

Form  of  bishop's  permission  to  an  incum- 
bent to  give  his  curate  notice  to  quit 
curacy,  or  give  up  possession  of  house  of 
residence. 

(^Applicable  to  Notice  No.  2  only). 

"  I, ,  Lord  Bishop  of ,  do  here- 
by, on  the  application  of  A.  B.,  clerk,  rector 

of ,  in   the   county  of  ' ,  and  my 

diocese  of ,  signify  my  permission  for 

him  to  require  and  direct  C.  D.,  clerk,  his 

licensed   curate  at  aforesaid,  to  quit 

and  give  up  the  said  curacy  [the  following 
to  be  added  where  applicable,  and  to  deliver 

up  possession  of  the  rectory  house  of 

aforesaid,  and  the  offices,  outhouses,  gar- 
dens, and  appurtenances  thereto  belonging, 
and  (if  any)  such  part  of  the  glebe  land  as 
has  been  assigned  to  the  said  C.  D.  as  such 
curate]  upon  six  calendar  months'  notice 
thereof  being  given  to  such  curate. 

Given  under  my  hand  this day 

of ,  one  thousand   eight  hun- 
dred and ." 

Note. — The  notice  No.  1  applies  only  to 
an  incumbent  newly  admitted  to  a  benefice, 
and  must  be  given  within  six  months  after 
such  admission. 

The  notice  No  2  applies  to  every  other 
case  of  an  incumbent  requiring  his  curate 
to  quit  the  curacy.  The  consent  of  the 
bishop  is  required  only  in  the  latter  case. 

The  H2th  section  of  the  Act  referred 
to  in  the  notices  contains  directions  as 
to  the  mode  in  which  the  notice  is  to  be 
served;  and  it  directs  that  "it  shall  be 
served  personally  upon  the  spiritual  person 
therein  named,  or  to  whom  it  shall  be  di- 
rected, by  showing  the  original  to  him  and 
leaving  with  him  a  true  copy  thereof,  or, 
in  case  such  spiritual  person  cannot  be 
found,  by  leaving  a  true  copy  thereof  at 
his  usual  or  last  known  place  of  residence, 
and  by  affixing  another  copy  thereof  upon 
the  church  door  of  the  parish  in  which 

*  This  nolice  must  be  dated  on  a  day  subsequent  to 
tlie  date  of  the  bishop's  permission. 


CUEATE 

such  place  of  residence  shall  be  situate." 
The  notice  must,  immediately  after  the 
service  thereof,  be  returned  into  the  Con- 
sistorial  Court  (or  the  Court  of  Peculiars, 
in  the  case  of  an  archbishop's  or  bishop's 
peculiar ;  see  sect.  108,),  and  be  there  filed, 
together  with  an  affidavit  of  the  time  and 
n-.anner  in  which  the  same  shall  have  been 
served. 

The  stipends  to  be  paid  to  curates  by 
non-resident  incumbents  must  be  in  con- 
formity with  the  directions  of  the  Act  of 
Parliament  1  &  2  Vict.  c.  106. 

Non-resident  incumbents  are  to  allow 
stipends  according  to  the  following  scale, 
prescribed  by  the  eighty-fifth  section  : 

The  lowest  stipend  is  .  .         .     £80 

If  the  population  amount  to  300, 
the  stipend  is  to  be  .         .  .  £100 

If  the  population  amount  to  500, 
the  stipend  is  to  be  .         .  .  £120 

If  the  population  amount  to  750, 
the  stipend  is  to  be  .         .         .  £135 

If  the  population  amount  to  1000, 
the  stipend  is  to  be  .  .  .  £150 
or  the  whole  value  of  the  benefice,  if  it  does 
not  exceed  these  sums  respectively.  Where 
the  net  yearly  income  of  a  benefice  exceeds 
£400,  the  bishop  may  (by  sect.  86)  assign 
a  stipend  of  £100,  notwithstanding  the 
population  may  not  amount  to  300;  and  if 
with  that  income  the  population  amounts 
to  500,  he  may  add  any  sum  not  exceeding 
£50  to  any  of  the  stipends  payable  by  the 
last-mentioned  incumbent,  where  the  curate 
resides  within  the  bene6ce,  and  serves  no 
other  cure.  Where  the  population  exceeds 
2000,  the  bishop  may  require  the  incumbent 
to  nominate  two  curates,  with  stipends  not 
exceeding  together  the  highest  rate  of  sti- 
pend allowed  to  one  curate. 

Incumbents  who  have  become  incapable 
of  performing  their  duties  from  age,  sickness, 
or  other  unavoidable  cause  (and  to  whom, 
from  these  or  from  any  other  special  and 
peculiar  circumstances,  great  hardship  would 
arise  if  they  were  required  to  pay  the  full 
stipend),  may  (by  sect.  87)  be  relieved  by 
the  bishop,  with  the  consent  of  the  arch- 
bishop of  the  province. 

The  bishop  may  (by  sect.  89)  direct  that 
the  stipend  to  a  curate  licensed  to  serve  two 
parishes  or  places,  shall  be  less  for  each  by  a 
sum  not  exceeding  £30  per  annum  than  the 
full  stipend. 

All  agreements  for  payment  of  a  less 
stipend  than  that  assigned  by  the  licence 
are  (by  sect.  90)  declared  to  be  void;  and 
if  less  be  paid,  the  remainder  may  be  after- 
wards recovered  by  the  curate  or  his  re- 
presentatives. When  a  stipend,  equal  to 
the  whole  value  of  a  benefice,  is  assigned  to 
the  curate,  he  is  (by  sect.  91)  to  be  liable 
to     all     charges     and    outgoings     legally 


CURFEW 


277 


affecting  the  benefice;  and  (by  sect.  94) 
when  such  a  stii)end  as  last  mentioned  is 
assigned,  and  the  curate  is  directed  to  reside 
in  the  glebe  house,  he  is  to  be  liable  to  the 
taxes,  parochial  rates,  and  assessments  of 
the  glebe  house  and  premises ;  but  in  every 
other  case  in  which  the  curate  shall  so 
leside  by  such  direction,  the  bishop  may,  if 
he  shall  think  fit,  order  that  the  incumbent 
shall  pay  the  curate  all  or  any  part  of  such 
sums  as  he  may  have  been  required  to  pay, 
and  shall  have  paid,  within  one  year,  ending 
at  Michaelmas  day  next  preceding  the  date 
of  such  order  for  any  such  taxes,  parochial 
rates,  or  assessments,  as  should  become  due 
at  any  titne  after  the  passing  of  the  Act. 

For  other  particulars  as  to  curates'  sti- 
pends and  allowances,  &c.,  see  the  Act  1  & 
2  Vict.  c.  106,  from  sect.  75  to  102,  both 
inclusive. 

CURE.  The  spiritual  charge  of  a  parish, 
or,  in  a  larger  sense,  the  parish  itself. 
When  Christianity  was  first  planted  in  this 
nation,  the  bishops  were  constantly  resident 
at  their  cathedrals,  and  had  several  clergy 
attending  them  at  that  place,  whom  they 
sent  to  preach  and  convert  the  people, 
where  there  was  the  greatest  probability  of 
success;  and  the  persons  thus  sent  either 
returned  or  continued  in  those  places,  as 
occasion  required,  having  no  fixed  cures  or 
titles  to  particular  places ;  for  being  all 
entered  in  the  bishop's  registry  (as  the 
usual  course  then  was),  they  could  not  be 
discharged  without  his  consent.  After- 
wards, when  Christianity  prevailed,  and 
many  churches  were  built,  the  cure  of  souls 
was  limited  both  as  to  places  and  persons. 
The  places  are  those  which  we  now  call 
parishes,  the  extent  whereof  is  certainly 
known,  and  the  boundaries  are  now  fixed 
by  long  usage  and  custom.  The  parsons 
are  the  ministers,  who,  by  presentation, 
institution,  and  induction,  are  entitled  to 
the  tithes  and  other  ecclesiastical  profits 
arising  within  that  parish,  and  have  the 
cure  of  souls  of  those  who  live  and  reside 
there :  and  this  the  canonists  call  a  cure  In 
foro  interiori  ianttim ;  and  they  distinguish 
it  from  a  cure  of  souls.  In  foro  exteriori, 
such  as  archdeacons  have,  to  suspend, 
excommunicate,  and  absolve,  and  which  is 
Sine  pastorali  cura :  and  from  another  cure, 
which  they  say  is  In  utroque  simul,  that  is, 
both  In  exteriori  et  interiori  foro  ;  and  such 
the  bishop  has,  who  has  a  superintendent 
care  over  the  whole  diocese,  intermixed  with 
jurisdiction. 

CURFEW  (Literally  a  fire  cover: 
couvre-feu).  The  ringing  of  a  bell  at  eight 
or  nine  o'clock  in  the  evening  is  a  curious 
relic  of  a  statute  of  William  the  Conqueror 
(repealed  in  1100  by  Henry  I.),  ordering 
all  fires  and  lights  to  be  extinguished  when 


278 


CURSIVE 


that  bell  raug  at  eight  o'clock.  Tlie  object  was 
to  keep  the  people  at  home  and  prevent  private 
meetings  with  a  view  to  rebellion.  It  is  still 
continued  in  a  great  many  places  with  a  slight 
change  of  time.  Thus  Great  Tom  of  Oxford  is 
tolled  101  times  every  night  at  nine,  and  the 
great  bell  of  St.  Mary's,  Cambridge,  rings  for 
a  quarter  of  an  hour,  and  then  tolls  the  day  of 
the  month.  It  is  continued  at  Lincoln's  Inu 
Chapel,  and  when  it  was  given  up  for  a  short 
time  experimentally,  a  remonstrance  was 
made  and  it  was  resumed.  In  some  places, 
as  at  Doncaster,  some  variation  is  made  in 
the  evening  bells  before  Sundays  and  Saints' 
days.  The  curfew  must  not  be  confounded 
with  the  gleaning  bell,  which  is  rung  some- 
what earlier  than  that  in  some  country 
churches  in  harvest  time.  An  early  morning 
bell  is  sometimes  still  rung  in  towns,  and 
called  the  "  Apprentices'  bell."     [G.] 

CURSIVE.  Those  manuscripts  which 
are  written  in  a  running  or  flowing  hand 
are  so  called  to  distinguish  them  from  the 
uncial,  which  are  printed  in  capitals.  The 
cursive  manuscripts  of  the  Gospels  alone, 
that  have  been  already  collated,  amount  to 
more  than  500  (Wordsworth,  Gk.  Test. 
xxxviii.).  The  uncial  style  of  writing  pre- 
vailed, speaking  broadly,  from  the  fourth  to 
the  tenth  century,  the  cursive  beginning 
in  the  ninth  or  tenth,  gradually  superseded 
ir,  and  lasted  until  the  invention  of  print- 
ins.    [H.] 

CUKTAINS  at  the  east  end  of  the 
chancel  were  sometimes  called  altar  veils. 
These  seem  to  have  been  generally  used 
in  England  instead  of  the  baldachin  or 
canopy  which  surrounds  the  altars  of 
foreign  churches;  but  solid  pillars  were 
substituted  for  them  in  the  elaborate  clas- 
Bioal  altar  screens  of  the  seventeenth  and 
eighteenth  centuries.  In  Durham  Cathedral 
those  which  were  anciently  in  daily  use 
were  of  white  silk  (Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  ii. 
p.  165).  Curtains  were  also  used  to  close 
the  doorway  between  the  nave  of  the 
church  and  the  sanctuary,  or  perhaps, 
rather,  to  fill  the  open  panels  or  cancelli  of 
the  door,  during  the  time  of  the  consecration 
of  the  Eucharist  (St.  Chrys.  in  Ephes. 
Horn.  iii.  sec.  5.  See  Smith  and  Cheetham's 
Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  p.  522).     [H.] 

CUSPS,  in  Gothic  architecture,  otherwise 
called  foliation,  arc  points  formed  by  small 
curves  projecting  inwards  from  the  subordi- 
nate arches  or  circles  of  windows  in  all  the 
styles  after  the  Early  English.  A  circle  in 
window  tracery  may  have  any  number  of 
cusps  from  three  \ip  to  eight,  which  number 
is  very  seldom  exceeded,  and  there  are  not 
often  more  than  six.  The  circles  are  then 
called  trefoils,  quatrefoils,  &c.  Each  side 
of  the  arch  at  the  head  of  the  long  window 
lights  generallj'  has  one  cusp  and  occasionally 


DAILY  CELEBEATION 

two,  but  never  more.  The  cusps  are  some- 
times a  mere  thin  flat  piece,  neither  pierced 
nor  decorated  ;  but  these  are  rare  in  genuine 
English  Gothic,  and  ugly.  They  are  often 
pierced  so  as  to  form 
what  are  called 
eyes :  and  some- 
times ornamented 
with  sunk  mould- 
ings or  with  raised 
carving.  When  the 
eyes  are  large  the 
cusp  looks  weak 
and  hardly  fit  for 
stone- work,  especi- 
ally when  also  thin 
from  back  to  front 
as  in  Figs.  2  and 
2a,  Figs.  1  and  la 
being  solid  cusps. 
Occasionally  win- 
dows of  several 
lights,  i.e.  not  single 
lancets,  are  left  un- 
cusped,  and  look 
very  bare  and  ugly.  Lancets  do  not  seem  to 
require  cusps,  and  were  generally  without, 
but  not  always.  In  very  rich  arcades  the 
hollow  of  a  large  cusp  is  sometimes  cusped 
again,  forming  what  is  called  "  double  folia- 
tion." 


D. 

DAILY  CELEBRATION  of  Holy  Com- 
munion. I.  The  passage  in  the  Acts,  where 
the  A]K)Stles  are  spoken  of  as  "  breaking  bread 
fi-om  house  to  house,"  or,  as  the  New  Ver- 
sion renders  it,  "  at  home,"  that  is,  in  their 
Christian  worship  apart  from  or  besides  the 
worship  in  the  temple  which  was  due 
from  them  as  Jews,  has  been  generally 
taken  to  refer  to  the  Holy  Communion. 
But  whether  the  " Kad'  fjfiipav"  at  the  be- 
ginning of  the  sentence  refers  to  this,  or 
only  to  their  " continuuig  with  one  accord" 
in  the  temple,  is  not  clear.  Nor  does  it 
appear  from  Holy  Scripture,  that  daily 
communion  became  a  custom  of  the  Church 
in  the  days  of  the  Apostles.  There  can  bo 
no  doubt,  however,  that  it  was  celebrated 
on  every  Lord's  Day,  if  not  oftener,  in  the 
earliest  ages  of  Christianity.  Ignatius,  in 
his  epistle  to  the  Ephesians,  exhorts  them 
to  be  diligent  in  assembling  frequently  to 
celebrate  the  Eucharist;  but  this  may 
simply  refer  to  the  Lord's  Day,  as  seems 
probable  from  a  statement  by  Pliny,  his 
contemporary  (lib.  x.  Ep.  97),  who  speaks 
of  the  Christians  always  binding  themselves 
bya  "saoramentum"  on  that  day.  Tcrtullian 
however  (a.d.  190-214)  speaks  of  a  greater 
frequency  of  celebrations.     On  Wednesdays, 


DAILY  CELEBRATION 

iPridays,  and  Saturdays,  on  all  festivals  of 
the  martyrs,  as  well  as  on  Sundays,  the 
Holy  Eucharist  was  celebrated,  and  between 
Easter  and  Pentecost  there  was  one  con- 
tinual festival,  during  which  without  doubt 
the  highest  festival  service  was  observed  on 
■each  day  (Tertull.  de,  Coron.  Mil.  iii. ;  de 
Orat.  c.  xiv.).  So  that  in  TertuUian's  days 
"there  must  have  really  been  daily  celebra- 
tions. Sixty  years  afterwards  St.  Cyprian 
says,  "  Eucharistiam  quotidie  ad  cibum 
■saluiis  accipimus."  Still  it  is  not  to  be 
supposed  tliat  in  every  place  the  same  rule 
■was  observed,  and  this  is  well  brought 
lefore  us  in  a  letter  by  St.  Augustine 
to  Januarius.  "  In  some  places,"  he  writes, 
"  no  day  jjasses  without  the  sacrifice  being 
•ofifered ;  in  others  it  is  only  on  Saturday  and 
the  Lord's  day,  or  it  may  be  only  on 
the  Lord's  day.  In  regard  to  these,  and  all 
■other  Variable  observances  which  may  be 
met  anywhere,  one  is  at  liberty  to  comply 
with  them  or  not  as  he  chooses ;  and  there 
■is  no  better  rule  for  the  wise  and  serious 
Christian,  than  to  conform  to  the  practice 
■which  he  finds  prevailing  in  the  Church  to 
^vhich  it  may  be  his  lot  to  come  "  (Letter 
LIV.).  In  the  Saoramentaries  provision  is 
<made  for  celebration  on  every  day  at  the 
more  sacred  seasons  of  the  year ;  and,  in 
general,  on  Wednesdays  and  Fridays  at 
'Other  times ;  and  this  is  also  the  case 
with  the  Salisbury  Missal,  which  during  a 
large  part  of  the  year  has  epistles,  gospels, 
■&c.,  for  several  or  all  of  the  week  days.  But 
no  canon  of  the  Church  of  England  exists 
imposing  daily  celebration  as  a  rule  on  the 
English  clergy,  though  the  rule  as  to  Sunday 
was  strict  and  definite. 

II.  "  The  first  Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI. 
looked  for '  daily  communion '  in  cathedrals  : 
^nd  in  parish  churches  for  communion  on 
Sundays  and  holy  days;  the  priest  being 
■ordered  earnestly  to  exhort  his  parishioners 
to  be  more  diligent  in  attendance,  if  he  saw 
them  negligent  to  come  on  those  days. 
Herein  the  practice  of  the  primitive  Church 
was  followed,  which  appears  to  have  con- 
•sidered  the  Holy  Communion  as  the  great 
(feature  of  public  woi'ship — the  centre  about 
which  it  all  revolved.  The  second  Prayer 
Book  of  King  Edward  relaxed  largely. 
Daily  communion  was  dropped,  even  in 
cathedrals,  and  weeldy  communion  substi- 
-tuted  for  it ;  and  on  holy  days  there  might 
or  might  not  be  a  communion.  The  declen- 
sion proceeded ;  and  accordingly  our  Church 
at  present  contents  herself  with  requiring  in 
the  rubric,  that  on  Sundays  and  holy-days, 
although  there  be  no  communion,  the 
service  be  read  to  the  end  of  the  prayer  for 
the  Church  Militant;  as  though  to  show 
thai  the  priest,  for  his  part,  is  ready  to  ad- 
minister on   those  days,  if  the  people  are 


DANCERS 


279 


ready  to  receive." — Blunt's  Parish  Priest, 
p.  340.     [H.] 

DAILY  PRAYERS.  "All  priests  and 
deacons  are  to  say  daily  the  morning  and 
evening  prayer,  either  privately  or  openly, 
not  being  let  by  sickness  or  some  other 
urgent  cause.  And  the  curate  that  minis- 
tereth  in  every  parish  church  or  chapel,  being 
at  home,  and  not  being  otherwise  reasonably 
hindered,  shall  sa}'  the  same  in  the  parish 
church  or  chapel  where  he  ministereth,  and 
shall  cause  a  bell  to  be  tolled  thereunto  a 
convenient  time  before  he  begin,  that  the 
people  may  come  to  hear  God's  word,  and 
pray  with  )xim.."^Preface  to  the  Booh  of 
Common  Prayer. 

DALMATIC  (from  Dalmatia,  where  it 
was  fii-st  manufactured,)  is  a  tunic  with 
long  sleeves,  reaching  below  the  knees,  and 
open  at  each  side  for  a  distance  varying  at 
different  periods.  It  is  not  marked  at  the 
back  with  a  cross  like  the  chasuble,  but  in 
the  Latin  Church  v/ith  two  narrow  stripes, 
the  remains  of  the  angusti  clavi  worn  on  the 
old  Roman  dress.  The  dalmatic  was 
originally  a  dress  of  state,  assumed  by 
senators,  and  persons  in  high  position,  and 
was  in  later  times  worn  by  sovereigns  at 
their  coronation.  The  first  trustworthy 
mention  of  it  as  an  ecclesiastical  dress  is 
in  an  order  of  Pope  Silvester,  a.d.  338,  "  that 
deacons  should  wear  '  dalmatics '  instead  of 
'coUobia'"  (Vit.  Silvest.  p.  266.  Ed. 
Combefis) ;  the  coUobion  being  a  Greek 
dress  of  somewhat  similar  shape.  The 
dalmatic  was  also  worn  by  bishops,  and  is 
seen  on  the  effigies  of  bishops  on  monu- 
ments, and  in  some  old  brasses,  over  the 
alb  and  the  stole,  the  fringed  extremities 
of  which  reach  just  below  it. 

In  the  ancient "  Celebratio  Ordinum,"  the 
dalmatic  was  given  to  the  deacons.  "  Time 
tradat  singulis  eos  ciroumeundo  dalmatic-am, 
dioens,"  &c.  But  the  English  Churches 
only  admitted  it  into  their  ordinal  early  in 
the  thirteenth  century.  It  is  not  noticed 
in  the  Winchester  pontifical,  but  ordered  in 
the  Bangor  MS.  (Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  Eccl. 
Ant.  ii.  212).  It  is  similar  to  the  tunicle, 
which  is  directed  to  be  worn  according  to 
the  rubrics  of  King  Edward  VI.'s  First 
Prayer  Book,  by  the  priests  and  deacons  who 
may  assist  thepriest  at  the  Holy  Communion 
(See  Tunicle:  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  523). 

DANCERS.  A  sect  which  originated  in 
the  year  1373  at  Aachen,  and  spread 
through  the  Belgic  provinces.  They 
wandered  about  from  place  to  place,  lived  by 
begging,  and  esteemed  the  public  worship  of 
the  Church  and  of  the  priesthood  of  little 
value.  At  public  or  private  assemblies 
persons  of  both  sexes  would  suddenly  begin 
dancing  in  a  most  violent  manner,  and  continue 
till  they  fell  down  exhausted.     A  somewhat 


280 


DANIEL 


similar  sect  rose  in  Frauce  in  the  eighteenth 
century,  called  "Convulsionists;"  and  more 
lately  the  Welsh  Methodists  developed  some 
"jumpers"  who  at  their  religious  services 
would  dance  about  crying  "Gogoniant," 
until  they  fell  down  breathless  and  mazed. 
In  America  this  sect  is  represented  by  the 
Shakers,  who  also  at  their  meetings  are 
wont  to  jump,  or  dance  till  exhausted, 
in  the  manner  of  the  dancing  dervishes  of  the 
Bast, — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  ii.  309  ; 
Blunt's  Diet.  Sects,  246. 

DANIEL  (THE  BOOK  OF).  A  canon- 
ical book  of  the  Old  Testament.  Daniel 
was  descended  from  the  royal  house  of 
the  kings  of  Judah,  and  was  contemporary 
with  Kzekiel  (a.c.  606).  He  was  of 
the  children  of  the  captivity,  being  carried 
to  Babylon  when  he  was  about  eighteen 
years  of  age.  His  name  is  not  prefixed  to 
his  book ;  yet  the  many  passages  in  which 
he  speaks  in  the  first  person,  are  a  sufficient 
proof  that  he  was  the  author  of  it. 

The  Jews  do  not  reckon  Daniel  among 
the  prophets ;  and  the  reason  they  assign  is, 
that  he  rather  lived  the  life  of  a  courtier, 
in  the  palace  of  the  king  of  Babylon,  than 
that  of  a  prophet.  They  add,  that,  though 
he  had  Divine  revelations  given  to  him,  yet 
it  was  not  in  the  prophetic  way,  but  by 
dreams  and  visions  of  the  night,  which 
they  look  upon  as  the  most  imperfect  way 
of  revelation,  and  below  the  prophetic. 
But  Josephus  {Antiq.  x.  12)  reckons  him 
among  the  greatest  of  the  prophets,  and 
says  further  of  him  that  he  conversed 
familiarly  with  Grod,  and  not  only  foretold 
future  events,  as  other  prophets  did,  but  de- 
termined likewise  the  time  when  they  should 
come  to  pass.  Our  Saviour,  by  acknowledg- 
ing Daniel  as  a  prophet,  puts  his  prophetic 
character  out  of  all  dispute  among  Christians. 
Part  of  the  book  of  Daniel  was  originally 
written  in  the  Chaldean  language ;  that  is, 
from  the  fourth  verse  of  the  second  chapter 
to  the  end  of  the  seventh  chapter  ;  and  the 
reason  was,  because,  in  that  part,  he  treats 
of  the  Chaldean  or  Babylonish  affairs.  All 
the  rest  of  the  book  is  in  Hebrew  (Hieron. 
in  Pnef.  ad  Dan.).  The  Greek  translation, 
used  by  the  Greek  Churches  throughout  the 
East,,  was  that  of  Theodotion.  In  the 
Vulgate,  there  is  added,  in  the  third  chapter, 
after  the  twenty-fourth  verse,  the  Song  of 
the  Three  Children,  and,  at  the  end  of  the 
book,  the  History  of  Susanna,  and  of  Bel 
and  the  Dragon :  the  former  is  made  the 
thirteenth,  and  the  latter  the  fourteenth  chap- 
ter of  the  book,  in  that  edition.  But  these 
additions  were  never  received  into  the  canon 
by  the  Jews ;  neither  are  they  extant  in  the 
Hebrew  or  the  Chaldee  language,  nor  is  there 
any  proof  that  they  ever  were  so  (See  Dible). 

It  is  believed  that  Daniel  died  in  Chaldea, 


DEACON 

and  that  he  did  not  take  advantage  of  the 
permission  granted  by  Cyrus  to  the  Jews  of 
returning  to  their  own  country.  St.  Epi- 
phanius  says  he  died  at  Babylon,  and  herein 
he  is  followed  by  the  generality  of  historians 
(Smith'sDict.o/Bibh:  Speaker's  Comment 
tary  and  Dr.  Pusey's:  Sir  I.  Newton's 
Observations  ore  Daniel,  pp.  15,  24) 

DARREIN  PRESENTMENT,  Assize  of. 
An  action  to  determine  the  lawful  patron  of 
a  benefice.  This  Inquest  was  instituted  by 
Henry  II.,  and  Magna  Charta  (Art.  18) 
directed  it  to  be  held  four  times  a  year  along 
with  the  assizes  of  mort  d'ancester  and 
novel  disseisin.  The  process,  however,  early 
became  obsolete,  as  the  writ "  quare  impe- 
dit "  supplied  a  readier  mode  of  prosecuting 
claims  to  advowson,  and  it  was  abolished  by 
3  &  4  Wm.  IV.  c.  27. 

DAVID,  ST.  The  national  saint  of  "Wales 
commemorated  in  the  English  Calendar  on 
March  1.  It  is  difBcult  to  disentangle  his 
real  history  from  the  mass  of  legend  with 
which  it  has  been  overlaid.  All  that  can  be 
asserted  with  any  degree  of  certainty  is  (1)  that 
he  established  a  see  and  monastery  at  Men- 
evia  late  in  the  sixth  or  early  in  the  seventh 
century,  selecting  the  site  probably  on  ac- 
count of  its  seclusion ;  (2)  that  his  diocese 
was  regarded  as  co-extensive  with  the  terri- 
tory of  the  Demeta; ;  (3)  that  he  took  a  pro- 
minent part  in  a  synod  of  the  British  held 
at  Llanddewi  Brefi,  near  the  site  of  the 
ancient  Loventium,  but  of  the  objects  of  this 
convention  nothing  is  certainly  kno^vn. 
His  dat«,  like  that  of  Dubricius,  first  bishop 
of  Llandaff,  has  been  put  back  by  the 
chroniclers  more  than  a  century,  in  order  to 
bring  him  into  connexion  with  King  Arthur ; 
but  he  probably  died  early  in  the  seventh 
century.  The  story  of  a  regular  Welsh 
archbishopric,  held  first  by  Dubricius  at 
Caerleon  and  transferred  by  David  to 
Menevia,  is  a  fable ;  nor  is  there  any  evidence 
that  the  Welsh  Church  in  that  age  had  any 
metropolitans. 

Bishop  David  was  canonised  in  a.d.  112S 
by  Pope  Calixtus  II.  (See  Haddan  and 
Stubbs,  vol.  i.  148, 149, 159  ;  Jones  and  Free- 
man's Eist.  of  St.  David's ;  Bright's  Early 
Engl.  Ch.  Eist.  p.  32). 

DATARY.  An  officer  in  the  Pope's 
court.  He  is  always  a  prelate,  and  some- 
times a  cardinal,  deputed  by  his  Holiness 
to  receive  such  petitions  as  are  presented 
to  him,  touching  the  provision  of  benefices. 

DEACON  (See  Bishop,  Presbyter, 
Priest,  Orders,  Clergy").  I.  The  name 
AmKovoi,  which  is  the  original  word  for 
deacons,  is  sometimes  used  in  the  New 
Testament  for  any  one  that  ministers  in  the 
service  of  God:  in  which  large  sense  we 
sometimes  find  bishops  and  presbyters  styled 
deacons,  not  only  in  the  New  Testament,  but 


DEACON 

in  ecclesiastical  writers  also.  But  here  we 
take  it  for  the  name  of  the  third  order  of 
the  clergy  in  the  Church.  Deacons  are 
styled  by  Ignatius  {Ep.  ad  Trull,  n.  2) 
"ministers  of  the  mysteries  of  Christ," 
adding  that  they  are  "  not  ministers  of 
meats  and  drinks,  but  of  the  Church  of  God." 
In  another  place  (Epist.  ad  Magnes,  n.  6) 
he  speaks  of  them  as  "  ministers  of  Jesus 
Christ,"  and  gives  them  a  sort  of  presidency 
over  the  people,  together  with  the  bishops 
and  presbyters.  Cyprian  speaks  of  them  in 
the  same  style,  calling  them  "  ministers  of 
episcopacy  and  the  Church,"  and  referring 
their  origin  to  the  Acts  of  the  Apostles ; 
and  he  asserts  that  they  were  called  ad 
altaris  ministerium,  to  the  ministry  and 
service  of  the  altar  (_Ep.  65  al.  3  ad 
Rogatian.').  Optatus  had  such  an  opinion  of 
them  as  to  reckon  their  office  a  lower  degree 
of  the  priesthood.  At  the  same  time  it  is 
to  be  observed,  that  in  this  he  was  singular. 
By  those  who  regarded  them  as  a  sacred 
order,  they  were  generally  distinguished 
from  priests  by  the  name  of  ministers  and 
Levites.  The  ordination  of  a  deacon  differed 
in  the  primitive  Church  from  that  of  a 
presbyter,  both  in  the  foiTn  and  manner  of 
it,  and  also  in  the  gifts  and  powers  that 
■were  conferred  by  the  ordinance.  In  the 
ordination  of  a  presbyter,  the  presbyters 
who  were  present  were  required  to  join  in 
imposition  of  hands  with  the  bishop.  But 
the  ordination  of  a  deacon  might  be  per- 
foi-med  by  the  bishop  alone,  because,  as  the 
[fourth]  Council  of  Carthage  words  it,  he 
"was  ordained  not  to  the  priesthood,  but 
to  the  inferior  services  of  the  Church; 
"quia  non  ad  sacerdotium  sed  ad  minis- 
terium consecratur."  It  belonged  to  the 
deacons  to  take  care  of  the  holy  table  and 
all  the  ornaments  and  utensils  appertaining 
thereto ;  to  receive  the  oblations  of  the 
people,  and  present  them  to  the  priest;  in 
some  churches,  to  read  the  Gospel  both  in 
the  communion  service  and  before  it  also; 
to  minister  the  consecrated  bread  and  wine 
to  the  people  in  the  Eucharist;  in  some 
churches,  to  baptize ;  to  act  as  directors  to 
the  people  in  public  worship,  for  which 
purpose  they  were  wont  to  use  certain 
known  forms  of  words,  to  give  notice  when 
each  part  of  the  service  began,  and  to  ex- 
cite people  to  join  attentively  therein;  to 
preach,  with  the  bishop's  licence;  in  ex- 
treme cases  to  reconcile  the  excommuni- 
cated to  the  Church;  to  attend  upon  the 
bishop,  and  sometimes  to  represent  him  in 
general  councils. — Bingham,  bk.  ii.  cxx. 

II.  The  deacon  was  never  allowed  to  pro- 
nounce the  absolution,  or  minister  at  the 
Holy  Communion,  except  as  an  assistant. 
"With  regard  to  baptism  in  ordinary  cases 
it  would  seem  that  in  some  places  deacons 


DEACON 


2S1 


had  the  authority  to  administer  it,  not  in 
others.  As  to  extraordinary  cases,  not  only 
deacons  but  laymen  were  admitted  to  baptize 
in  the  primitive  Church.  According  to  the 
Apostolic  Constitutions,  a  deacon  may  not 
"baptize  or  offer"  (viii.  28),  but  is  to  minister 
to  the  bishops  and  presbyters  therein  (iii. 
11) ;  and  Epiphanius  affirms  the  same  (Haer. 
79 ;  Collysid.  n.  4).  But  from  TertuUian,  St. 
Jerome,  St.  Cyril  and  others,  it  appears  that 
deacons  had  this  power  "  by  the  bishop's 
leave."  The  fifth  canon  of  the  Council  of 
York,  1195,  decreed  "  ut  non  nisi  summa 
et  gravi  necessitate  diaconus  baptiset " 
(Wilkins,  Condi,  i.  501).  But  the  general 
rule  seems  to  have  been,  as  it  is  at  present, 
that  he  might  baptize,  but  only  in  the  ah- 
sence  of  the  priest  (See  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit. 
ii.  202). 

The  ancient  rule  of  the  Church  in  respect 
of  marriages  was  that  they  should  be  cele- 
brated "  per  presbyterum  Sanctis  ordinibus 
constitutum."  No  change  was  made  in  this 
rule  at  the  Reformation  or  subsequently : 
and  there  is  no  authority  for  a  deacon  cele- 
brating the  rite.  Chief  Justice  Tindal  gave 
his  opinion,  and  that  of  his  brother  judges, 
before  the  House  of  Lords  on  July  7th,  1843, 
that  it  was  the  rule  of  the  Church  of  England 
to  require  the  ceremony  to  be  perfoimed  by 
a  priest.  This  indeed  was  a  question  about 
clergj'men  and  laymen,  not  deacons  and 
priests ;  but  the  marriage  office  is  certainly 
one  of  Benediction,  which  is  beyond  the 
power  of  a  deacon  ;  the  rubrics  throughout 
contemplate  the  minister  of  the  office  as  a 
priest;  and  no  authority  is  given  to  the 
deacon  to  celebrate  marriages  at  his  ordina- 
tion or  at  any  other  time  (Blunt's  Annot. 
P.  B.  264). 

If  the  rubrics  be  strictly  construed  ac- 
cording to  the  letter,  the  deacon  cannot  read 
the  versicles  before  the  Psalms,  or  after  the 
Lord's  Prayer  (at  its  second  occurrence), 
nor  the  latter  part  of  the  Litany,  beginning 
at  the  Lord's  Prayer;  nor  any  part  of  the 
Communion  Service,  except  the  Gospel  (not 
according  to  the  rubric,  however,  but  in 
virtue  of  the  licence  in  the  Ordination 
Service),  the  Creed,  and  the  Confession. 
These  rubrics  are  now  much  more  generally 
observed  than  they  used  to  be. 

III.  The  Church  of  England  enjoins  (and 
there  is  an  Act  to  the  same  effect  (44  Geo. 
III.  c.  43)),  that  "  none  shall  be  admitted  a 
deacon  except  he  be  twenty-three  years  of 
age,  unless  he  have  a  faculty  "  (see  Aye) ;  and 
she  describes  the  duties  of  a  deacon  in  her 
office  as  follows :  "  It  appertaineth  to  the 
office  of  a  deacon,  in  the  church  where  he 
shall  be  appointed  to  serve,  to  assist  the 
priest  in  Divine  service,  and  sjjecially  when 
he  ministereth  the  Holy  Communion,  and  to 
help  him  in  the  distribution   thereof,  and 


282 


DEACONESS 


to  read  Holj'  Scripture  and  homilies  in  the 
church ;  and  to  instruct  the  youth  in  the 
catechism ;  in  the  absence  of  the  priest  to 
baptize  infanta,  and  to  preach,  if  he  be 
admitted  thereto  by  the  bishop.  And, 
furthermore,  it  is  his  office,  where  provision 
is  so  made,  to  search  for  the  sick,  poor,  and 
impotent  people  of  the  parish,  to  intimate 
their  estates,  names  and  places  where  they 
■dwell,  unto  the  curate,  that  by  his  exhorta- 
tion they  may  be  relieved  with  the  alms  of 
the  ]5arishioners,  or  others."     [H.] 

DEACONESS.  A  woman-deacon.  An 
order  and  office  in  the  Church,  possibly 
■derived  from  the  older  order  ef  Widows 
(Acts  vi.  1 ;  1  .Tim.  v.  9).  Its  scriptural 
authority  is  equal,  or  superior  to,  that  of 
the  episcopate.  It  is  directly  mentioned  by 
St.  Paul  (Komans  xvi.  and  1  Tim.  iv.  11), 
and  was  undoubtedly  a  prominent  feature 
of  the  Apostolic  Church. 

In  the  century  next  after  the  Ajiostles, 
and  thenceforward  for  several  centuries,  we 
find  not  only  deaconesses  working  in  the 
cities  and  dioceses,  but  deaconesses  admitted 
by  formal  imposition  of  the  hands  of  the 
bishop,  constituting  a  distinct  order  of  the 
primitive  ministry.  They  were  always 
widows  or  unmarried.  They  were  generally 
of  mature  age — according  to  the  Council  of 
Ohalcedon  not  less  than  forty,  though  it 
seems  certain  that  in  some  cases  an  earlier 
jige  was  admitted.  Their  duties  were  to 
visit,  tend,  and  nurse  the  poor,  the  sick, 
and  the  afiiicted,  signally  those  of  their  own 
«ex  ;  to  minister  to  the  martyrs  in  prison ; 
to  prepare  female  converts  for  holy  baptism, 
and  attend  them  at  the  time ;  and  probably 
to  teach  generally  the  young  converts  or 
young  children  of  the  Church  ;  to  preside 
over  those  widows  who  were  pensioners  on 
the  Christians'  bounty ;  to  keep  order  among 
the  female  worshippers  in  the  house  of 
prayer ;  and  to  be  the  means  of  introduction 
and  communication  between  the  clergy 
and  the  women  of  their  flock.  But  in  no 
•case  were  they  permitted  to  exercise  sacer- 
dotal functions. 

The  office  and  order  of  deaconess  lasted 
for  ten  or  twelve  centuries  in  the  churches 
of  the  East.  It  had  fallen  out  of  use  much 
earlier  in  the  West,  probably  before  the 
end  of  the  eighth  century.  It  had  been 
found  necessary  to  confine  it  to  persons 
living  under  special  rale  of  life,  and  in 
•community  ;  and  it  was  superseded  by  the 
great  independent  communities  or  nunneries. 

These  conventual  establishments  being 
essentially  lay  institutions,  were  not  canon- 
ically  subject  to  the  bishop  of  the  diocese, 
and  very  generally  defied  his  interference, 
while  they  exercised  great  spiritual  power 
in  his  diocese.  And  the  last  stage  in  the 
mediseval  history  of  the  female  diaconate  in 


DEACONESS 

the  West  was  its  adoption  by  the  bishops  to 
support  the  diocesan  system  when  seriously 
threatened  by  this  danger.  ; 

In   this   view    they    insisted    upon    the      j 
superiors    of    the    nunneries    being    made      ' 
deaconesses,  just  as  they  sought  to  compel      ' 
the   higher  officials  in   the  monasteries  to 
receive  ordination,  in  order  toobtain  canonical 
rights  over  them.     Other  circumstances  con- 
spired to  reduce  the  communities  to  sub- 
mission, and  the  order  of  deaconess  then  fell 
completely  into   abeyance.      But  abbesses 
seem  to  have  sometimes  retained  the  title 
of  deaconess  for  some  time  after  the  actual 
office  had  passed  away. 

The  setting  apart  of  women  for  the  work 
of  visiting  and  in.structing  the  poor,  for 
tending  the  sick  and  generally  for  such 
benevolent  ministrations  as  women  are 
well  adapted  for,  was  revived  on  a  con- 
siderable scale  by  Gennan  and  French 
Protestants  at  Kaisersworth  in  1836,  at 
Strasburg  and  Muhlhauseu  in  184:2,  and 
the  time-honoured  title  of  deaconess  was 
assumed  by  them.  These  have  grown  into 
flourishing  institutions.  But  these  so-called 
deaconesses  are  not  to  be  confounded  with 
the  Apostolic  order  and  office.  It  has  un- 
fortunately resulted  from  the  unauthorised 
assumption  of  the  ancient  and  apostolical 
title  by  these  women,  upon  whom  no  .such 
office  was  canonically  confen-ed,  that  their  ex- 
ample has  been  followed  in  England,  and 
that  the  name  is  frequently  claimed  by 
many  women  who  are  often  mere  nurses, 
and  are  in  no  way  connected  officially  with 
the  order  of  the  Catholic  Church. 

In  1861,  after  being  in  abeyance  for  one 
thousand  years,  the  ancient  order  was  at  last 
revived  in  the  person  of  Catherine  Elizabeth 
Ferard,  invested  duly  with  the  office  of 
deaconess  by  Bishop  Tait  of  London.  Since 
that  time  it  has  maintained  its  ground. 

There  are  now  deaconesses  in  several 
English  dioceses,  generally  associated  in 
communities  to  live  in  a  certain  state  of 
life  (see  Sisterhoods),  but  attached  for 
temporary  or  permanent  work  to  particular 
parish  churches,  or  to  the  care  of  special 
benevolent  institutions. 

They  are  sometimes  called  sisters,  but 
this  title  refers  only  to  their  state  of  life, 
not  to  their  office  in  the  Church,  and  is  of 
course  inapplicable  to  those  deaconesses  who 
do  not  belong  to  a  sisterhood.  Their  duties 
are  much  the  same  as  those  of  the  deaconesses 
of  the  primitive  Church.  Various  questions 
are  still  unsettled  as  to  their  position  in  the 
Church,  the  tenure  of  their  office,  the  regu- 
lation of  their  outward  life,  the  possibility 
of  their  being  married,  &c.  It  seems  to  be 
generally  agreed  that  women-deacons  should 
be  as  closely  as  possible  on  parallel  lines 
with  the  men-deacons  of  the  Apostolic  age. 


DEAD 

owing  canonical  obedience  to  the  bishop  of 
the  dincese,  and  that  their  communities 
should  be  directly  under  his  personal  control, 
and  should  not  be  subject  to  the  incumbent 
of  the  parish  in  which  they  are  situated. 
Above  all,  it  is  a  matter  of  experience,  that 
none  should  be  admitted  to  the  office  with- 
out training  and  probation. 

The  complete  adjustment  and  discipline 
of  the  revived  order  and  office  of  women- 
deacons  in  the  English  branch  of  the 
Oatholic  Church  awaits  the  formation  of  a 
canonical  system  in  the  synods  of  the 
English  provinces.  This  alone  can  prevent 
distracting  collisions  of  merely  diocesan 
regulations.    [B.  C] 

DEAD  (See  Burial).  I.  At  all  times, 
and  among  all  nations,  funeral  rites,  of  some 
sort  or  other,  have  been  performed  over  the 
dead.  The  most  ancient  manner  was  by 
"  laying  them  in  the  earth,"  sometimes  em- 
balming them  first,  as  in  the  case  of  the 
Egyptians  and  other  nations  of  the  East, 
and  sometimes  placing  them  as  they  were  in 
the  ground.  There  is  abundant  testimony 
in  the  books  of  Moses  of  the  burial  of  their 
dead  by  the  patriarchs,  and  it  is  evident 
that  their  funerals  were  performed,  and  their 
sepulchres  provided  with  pious  care  (Gen. 
xxiii.  4 ;  xxv.  9 ;  xxxv.  29 ;  xlix.  31). 
Among  certain  nations,  notably  the  Greeks 
and  Romans,  it  became  a  custom  to  burn 
the  bodies  of  the  dead  (see  Phny,  Nat.  Hist. 
1.  7,  c.  54).  And  it  has  been  imagined  by 
some  from  1  Sam.  xxxi.  12,  and  Amos 
vi.  10,  that  the  rite  of  burning  was  also 
sometimes  used  by  the  Jews.  But  it  appears 
that  the  burnings  there  mentioned  were 
simply  the  burning  of  odours  and  spices 
about  their  bodies — an  honour  usually  paid 
to  kings  (2  Chron.  xvi.  14 ;  xxi.  19  ; 
Jer.  xxxiv.  5).  As  with  the  Jews,  so  with 
the  Christians,  the  rite  of  interment,  with 
religious  observances,  was  the  only  one ;  and 
wherever  Paganism  was  extirpated,  the 
•custom  of  burning  was  disused,  and  that  of 
laying  the  bodies  of  the  deceased  entire  in 
the  grave  took  its  place. 

IL  From  the  primitive  ages  of  Christian- 
ity, the  greatest  care  has  been  taken  with  re- 
gard to  the  dead,  in  closing  their  eyes,  laying 
them  forth,  watching  with  them,  washing 
their  bodies,  dressing  them,  and  carrying 
them  to  burial  with  psalms  and  hymns 
(See  Euseb.  lib.  vii.  22,  &c.).  The  singing  of 
psalms,  expressive  of  the  joy  and  hope  with 
•which  the  separation  of  death  was  regarded, 
■was  always  the  custom  at  the  burial  of  the 
dead.  In  the  Apostolic  Constitutions  the 
direction  is  given,  "  in  the  funerals  of  the 
departed,  accompany  them  with  singing,  if 
they  were  faithful  in  Christ "  (vi.,  xxx.),  and 
many  passages  in  the  Fathers  show  the  im- 
portance   that  was  attached  to   this    part 


DEAD 


283 


of  the  rite  (e.g.  St.  Chrysost.  Horn.  iv.  in 
Hebr.  29 ;  de  Dormient.  hieron.  Ep.  xxvii.). 
Jlinisters  also  were  appointed,  with  a  sort 
of  clerical  character,  to  look  after  the 
funerals,  and  take  heed  that  all  was  done  in 
order,  who  were  styled  "  Co]iiata3,"  or 
"  Fossarii  "  (Bingham,  iii.  8).  The  mediai- 
val  services  included,  (1)  the  commenda- 
tion of  the  souls  of  the  dead,  said  in  the 
house  between  the  death  and  burial;  (2) 
the  Inhumation ;  (3)  the  mass  for  the 
dead,  or  Requiem ;  (4)  the  office  for  the  dead, 
called  the  "  Dirge  " ;  (5)  Trentals,  or  masses 
said  for  thirty  days  after  the  day  of  death ; 
and  (6)  anniversary  commemorations.  In 
the  Prayer  Book  of  1549,  there  was  a  prayer 
for  the  soul  of  the  departed,  beginning,  "O 
Lord,  with  whom  do  live  the  spirits  of 
tliem  that  he  dead,  and  in  whom  the  souls 
of  them  that  be  elected,  after  they  be  de- 
livered from  the  burden  of  the  flesh,  be  in 
joy  and  felicity;  grant  unto  this  Thy  servant, 
that  the  sins  which  he  committed  in  this 
world  be  not  imputed  unto  him,"  &c. 
There  was  also  to  be  a  celebration  of  Holy 
Communion,  a  practice  dating  as  early  as 
the  fifth  century.  But  in  the  Prayer  Book 
of  1552,  the  prayer  and  the  celebration  of 
Holy  Communion  were  omitted,  as  also 
the  words  to  b2  spoken  by  the  priest  as  he 
cast  earth  upon  the  corpse,  "  I  commend 
thy  soul  to  God,  and  thy  body  to  the 
ground."  The  present  form  of  commenda- 
tion was  substituted,  according  to  which 
the  words  with  regard  to  the  body  only  are 
spoken  by  the  minister,  while  "someone 
standing  by  "  casts  earth  upon  the  body. 

III.  With  regard  to  the  condition  of  the 
dead  in  Christ-  intermediately  till  their 
bodies  are  raised,  it  must  he  observed  that 
no  practice  is  of  more  primitive  antiquity 
than  that  of  praying  for  ihe  souls  of  the 
faithful  departed.  Tertullian,  the  opposer 
of  any  innovation,  speaks  of  it  frequently  as 
the  established  rule  of  the  Church  {de  Cor. 
Mil.  c.  3;  Exhort,  ad  Castit.  c.  11,  &c.). 
Cyprian,  Origen,  Cyril,  nearly  all  the  fathers 
in  fact,  refer  to  it.  In  all  the  old  liturgies 
there  are  prayers  for  "  all  souls,  that  they 
may  have  rest  in  the  land  of  the  living,  in 
the  Paradise  of  God"  (Neale's  Anct.  Lit.). 
"  It  may  be  observed,"  says  Bishop  Heber, 
"  that  ttie  Greek  Church  and  all  the  Eastern 
Churches,  though  they  do  not  believe  in 
"  purgatory,"  pray  for  the  dead ;  and  that 
we  know  the  practice  to  have  been  univei'sal, 
or  nearly  so,  among  the  Christians,  a  little 
more  than  150  years  after  our  Saviour." 
Augustine,  in  his  Confessions,  has  given  a 
beautiful  prayer,  which  he  himself  used  for 
his  deceased  mother,  Monica;  and  among 
Protestants,  Luther  and  Dr.  Johnson  are 
eminent  instances  of  the  same  conduct. 
To  the  same  effect  Jeremy  Taylor  writes, 


284 


DEADLY  SIX 


"  Siicb  general  prayers  for  the  dead  as  those 
ahove  reckoned  (i.e.  as  used  by  the  primitive 
Christian),  the  Church  of  England  never 
did  condemn  by  any  express  article,  but 
left  it  in  the  middle;  and  by  her  practice 
declares  her  faith  of  the  resurrection  of  the 
dead,  and  her  interest  in  the  communion  of 
saints,  and  that  the  saints  departed  are  a 
portion  of  the  Catholic  Church,  parts  and 
members  of  the  body  of  Christ ;  but  ex- 
pressly condemns  the  doctrine  of  purgatory, 
and  consequpntly  all  prayers  for  the  dead 
relating  to  it "  (Taylor's  Works,  Heber's  ed., 
vol.  X.  p.  148.     See  Purgatory).    [U.] 

DEADLY  SIN.  We  pray  in  the  Litany 
to  be  delivered  from  "  all  deadly  sin."  In 
the  strict  sense  of  the  word,  every  sin  is 
deadly,  and  would  cause  eternal  death  if  it 
were  not  for  the  intervention  of  our  blessed 
Saviour.  Even  what  are  called  infirmities 
and  frailties  are  in  this  sense  deadly.  But 
persons  under  grace  have  for  these  offences 
"  an  Advocate  with  the  Father,  Jesus  Christ 
the  righteous,  and  He  is  the  propitiation  for 
our  sins  "  (1  St.  John  ii.  2).  Their  infirmities 
and  frailties,  therefore,  if  they  are  trying  to 
overcome  them,  are  not  deadly  to  persons 
tinder  grace,  or  baptized  persons  justified  by 
faith,  although,  if  persevered  in,  and  un- 
corrected, they  may  terminate  in  deadly 
sin;  and  they  consequently  require  con- 
tinual repentance,  lest;  they  should  grow 
into  such  a  fearful  burden.  But  even  to 
persons  under  grace  we  learn  from  1  St.  John 
V.  16,  17,  that  there  are  "  sins  unto  death," 
— which  must  mean  sins  that  put  vrs  out  of 
a  state  of  grace,  and  this  is  done  by  any 
wilful  sin  persevered  in.  Pride,  avarice, 
lust,  envy,  gluttony,  anger,  sloth,  have  been 
called  the  "  seven  deadly  sins ; "  but  by 
deadly  sin  in  a  Christian  is  meant  wilful 
sin,  persevered  in,  which  deprives  us  of  all 
Christian  privileges  (See  Sin). 

DEAN.  I.  Certain  officers  of  the  college 
or  guild  of  Copiata3  at  Constantinople,  whose 
duty  it  was  to  ari'ange  and  attend  funerals, 
were  called  decani  (See  Copiatie,  Bingham, 
bk.  iii.  0.  8).  But  the  term  was  more 
usually  applied  to  the  heads  of  the  "  decu- 
ries  "  in  monasteries,  especially  in  those  of 
the  Benedictine  order.  The  whole  convent 
was  thus  divided,  and  the  dean  or  tenth 
]ierson  presided  over  the  other  nine.  His 
duty  was  to  see  after  every  man's  daily 
work,  and  give  an  accoimt  of  it  to  the 
ojconomus,  or  steward,  who  had  to  give  a 
monthly  account  to  the  head,  or  abbot. 
"  Opusdici  statum  est,  quod  decano  redditum, 
fertur  ad  oeconomum,  qui  et  ipse  per  singulos 
menses  patri  omnium  reddit  rationem  "  (St. 
Jerome,  Ep.  22,  ad  Eustocli.  c.  15).  This 
rule  was  consistently  carried  on,  and  when 
in  later  times  cathedral  establishments 
contrasted   unfavourably  Avilh    the    Bone- 


DEAN 

dictine  monasteries,  an  attempt  was  made 
in  the  middle  of  the  8th  century  to  effect  a 
reform  in  J'rance.  Chrodegang,  archbishop 
of  Metz,  gave  to  the  cathedral  clergy  a 
canon  or  rule  of  a  serai-monastic  character. 
There  were  canons  before  the  time  of  Chro- 
degang, and  the  name  was  probably  derived 
from  the  Kavav  or  list  on  which  they  were 
enrolled,  not  from  the  rule  which  they  ob- 
served. As  the  monks  were  placed  under 
the  superintendence  of  a  "  decanus  "  or  of  a 
prior,  so  the  canons  were  subjected  to  a  dean 
(Hook's  Lives  (if  the  Archbishops,  vol.  i.  284). 
The  system  was  introduced  into  England, 
and  Ceolnoth,  afterwards  archbishop,  was  the 
first  dean  of  Canzerbury,  in  a.d.  826.  The 
arrangement  seems,  however,  not  to  have 
succeeded  at  first,  and  the  time  of  its  intro- 
duction was  unfortunate.  The  historians 
of  the  day,  being  monks,  and  opposed 
to  cathedral  establishments  under  secular 
canons,  have  not  given  any  particulars.  It 
is  certain,  however,  that  there  was  a  dean 
of  St.  Paul's  in  1086,  and  from  that  time 
or  soon  after  all  the  cathedrals  in  England 
which  were  not  served  by  monks  had  a  dean 
as  their  head,  ■ixdthout  whom  the  Corporation 
of  the  Dean  and  Chapter  is  incomplete. 
But  some  of  the  collegiate  churches,  and  also 
several  of  the  Welsh  cathedrals  until  1840, 
were  without  deans,  of  which  Southwell 
with  a  large  body  of  prebendaries  was  the 
chief  example. 

The  dean  is  the  first  dignitary  of  the 
cathedral ;  the  head  of  the  corporation ;  and, 
in  subordination  to  the  bishop,  has,  according 
to  the  statutes  of  more  ancient  cathedrals, 
the  cure  of  soids  over  the  members  of  the 
cathedral,  and  the  administration  of  the 
corrective  discipline  of  the  Church.  He  has 
also  duties  in  the  choir  and  the  chapter  in 
common  with  all  the  chapter.  He  is  by 
our  law  a,  sole  corporation,  that  is,  he  re- 
presents a  whole  succession,  and  is  capable 
of  taking  an  estate  as  dean,  and  conveying 
it  to  his  successors.  But  all  their  sepa- 
rate estates  were  taken  away  by  the  Act 
of  1840. 

The  deans  have  different  degrees  of 
power  under  the  statutes  of  different 
churches.  At  Westminster  he  is  generally 
understood  to  be  absolute :  at  any  rate 
Dean  Stanley  insisted  that  he  was.  At 
Dm-ham,  it  appears  from  the  reports  of  the 
last  cathedral  commission,  that  the  Dean 
has  lately  claimed  absolute  authority  over 
the  services ;  and  a  legal  opinion  is  printed 
that  the  claim  is  good  though  new.  In 
some  other  cathedrals  it  seems  to  be  alleged 
that  the  deans  have  gradually  usurped 
more  power  than  they  have  legally.  In 
others  they  have  not  even  a  casting  vote  in 
addition  to  their  single  one.  At  Peter- 
borough lately  it  was  of  public  notoriety 


DEAN 

that  a  majority  of  the  chapter  voted  down 
both  the  dean  and  a  large  majority  of  the 
committee  which  had  the  command  of  the 
funds,  and  weakly  submitted  to  arbitration, 
in  the  matter  of  the  rebuilding  of  the  tower. 
In  some  chapters  the  dean  has  a  casting 
vote  besides  his  primary  one.  By  the  great 
cathedral  reform  Act  of  1840  the  deans  are 
ordered  to  reside  eight  months,  and  they  can 
only  hold  a  living  of  less  than  £500  a  year 
(gross  value)  besides,  within  three  miles  of 
the  cathedral ;  and  if  they  have  any  living 
except  such  as  those  it  becomes  vacant  in 
six  months  after  their  appointment  as  dean ; 
but  it  does  not  go  to  the  Crown  like  bishops' 
preferments.  The  incomes  of  the  deans 
were  dealt  with  most  unfairly  by  the  Act 
of  1840,  which  reduced  all  above  £2000  a 
year  to  that,  but  made  not  a  few  as  low 
as  £1000  a  year  by  taking  away  all  the 
separate  property,  and  in  some  cases  with 
houses  large  enough  for  a  bishop's  palace.  The 
moomes  appear  in  Whitaker's  Almanaclc. 
Altogether  the  office  and  position  of  deans 
are  considered  to  be  in  a  very  unsatisfactory 
condition,  and  various  schemes  have  been 
proposed  for  both  increasing  their  usefulness 
and  restoring  better  relations  between  them 
and  the  bishops  than  notoriously  exist  in 
some  places.  One  commission,  of  1854, 
went  so  far  as  to  recommend  consolidating 
the  two  offices,  which  sunply  means  abolish- 
ing deans,  and  making  the  bishops  the 
real  instead  of  the  nominal  heads  of  their 
chapters  once  more.  Another  plan  suggested 
is  to  utilize  them  as  suffragan  bishops  under 
the  Act  of  26  Hen.  VIII.  c.  74,  as  such 
are  frequently  wanted,  and  there  are  no 
funds  to  pay  them  now  that  the  cathedral 
patronage  has  been  so  enormously  reduced. 
It  would  be  out  of  place  to  discuss  the  rival 
schemes  here :  we  only  notice  them. 

II.  Deans,  Rural.  Their  office  is  of 
ancient  date  in  the  Church  of  England,  long 
prior  to  the  Reformation,  as  it  has  been 
throughout  Europe.  In  one  of  the  laws 
ascribed  to  Edward  the  Confessor,  the  rural 
dean  is  called  the  dean  of  the  bishop  {Ken. 
Par.  Ant.  633).  1'heir  chief  duty  is  to 
visit  a  certain  number  of  parishes,  and  to 
report  their  condition  to  the  bishop.  Till 
within  the  last  few  years  the  title  of  Rural 
Dean  in  modern  times  existed  only  in  name. 
But  now  they  hold  chapters,  at  which 
subjects  submitted  to  them  by  the  bishop 
are  discussed,  and  they  present  a  report 
annually  to  the  bishop  of  their  diocese  (See 
Enrol  Deans). 

Rural  deans  are  recognised  by  37  &  38 
Vict.  c.  63,  authorising  new  deaneries  to  be 
formed  by  the  bishop  and  the  Ecclesiastical 
Commissioners ;  but  every  rural  deanery  is 
to  be  wholly  within  one  archrleaconry ;  and 
also  every  archdeaconry  wholly  within  one 


DEAN  AND  CHArTER 


2S5 


diocese,  the  Act  containing  powers  also  to 
re-arrange  them. 

III.  1'he  "Dean  of  Faculty"  in  most 
ancient  and  some  modern  universities, 
presided  over  the  meetings  at  their  several 
faculties,  and  maintained  the  academical 
discipline.  There  are  also  deans  in  nearly 
all  the  Oxford  and  Cambridge  colleges,  who 
generally  have  the  chief  management  of 
the  chapel  discipline  and  services,  and  are 
always  Fellows  of  their  college. 

IV.  There  are  also  a  few  titular  "  Deans 
of  Peculiars,"  though  the  Peculiar  juris- 
dictions are  abolished.  They  are  mere 
incumbents,  who  have  kept  the  title,  which 
is  now  unmeaning  and  misleading.  The 
Bishop  of  London  is,  as  a  "  peculiar,"  dean 
of  the  province  of  Canterbury.    [H.] 

DEAN  AND  CHAPTEU.  This  is  the 
style  and  title  of  the  governing  body  of  a 
cathedral.  A  chapter  consists  of  the  dean, 
with  a  certain  number  of  canons,  or  preben- 
daries, heads  of  the  church — capita  ecclesim. 
The  origin  of  this  institution  is  to  be  traced 
to  a  remote  antiqui  ty.  A  missionary  bishop, 
when  converting  our  ancestors,  commonly 
fixed  his  see  in  some  spot  which  either  from 
its  central  position,  or  from  its  proximity 
to  the  royal  court,  was  the  most  convenient 
abode  for  him  and  his  attendant  priests, 
who  as  op|X)rtunity  offered,  would  go  to  the 
neighbouring  villages  to  preach  the  gospel, 
and  administer  the  other  offices  of  the 
Church.  But  they  resided  with  the  bishop, 
and  were  supported  out  of  his  revenues.  By 
degrees  parochial  settlements  were  made ; 
but  still  the  bishop  required  the  attendance 
of  certain  of  the  clergy  at  his  cathedral,  to 
be  his  council ;  and  also  to  officiate  in  his 
principal  church  or  cathedral.  These  persons, 
to  qualil'y  themselves  for  their  office,  gave 
themselves  up  to  study,  and  to  the  main- 
tenance and  decoration  of  their  sanctuary ; 
the  services  of  which  were  to  be  a  model  to 
all  the  lesser  churches  of  the  diocese.  Form- 
ing, in  the  course  of  time,  a  corporation,  they 
obtained  property,  and  ceased  to  be  dependent 
upon  the  bishop  for  a  maintenance.  And 
being  considered  the  representatives  of  the 
clergy,  upon  them  devolved  the  government 
of  the  diocese  when  vacant;  and  they 
obtained  the  privilege,  doubtless  on  the  same 
principle,  of  choosing  the  bishop,  which 
originally  belonged  to  the  whole  clergy  of  the 
diocese,  in  conjunction  with  the  bishops  of 
the  province.  In  this  privilege  they  were 
supported  by  the  kings  of  the  country,  who 
perceived  that  they  were  more  likely  to 
intimidate  a  chapter  into  the  election  of  the 
royal  nominee,  than  the  whole  of  the  clergy 
of  a  diocese.  But  still,  the  deans  and 
chapters  sometimes  acting  indejiendently, 
an  Act  was  passed  in  1533  (25  Hen.  VIII. 
c.  20),  by  which  a  dean  and  chapter  re- 


286 


DECALOGUE 


fusing  to  elect  tte  king's  nominee  to  the 
Ushopric  become  individually  outlawed,  lose 
all  their  property,  and  are  to  be  imprisoned 
during  pleasure,  and  the  sovereign  then 
appoints  by  letters  patent.  The  Act  3  & 
'4  Vict.  c.  113,  which  has  -wrought  a  con- 
siderable change  in  the  condition  and 
constitution  of  deans  and  chapters,  is  given 
at  length  in  Phillimore's  Eccl.  Law  (See 
Canons  and  Cathedrals). 

DECALOGrUE.  The  ten  precepts,  or 
commandments,  delivered  by  God  to  Moses, 
and  by  him  written  on  two  tables  of  stone, 
and  delivered  to  the  Hebrcw.s,  as  the  basis 
and  foundation  of  their  religion.  The  history 
of  this  great  event,  together  with  the  ten 
commandments  themselves,  are  recited  at 
large  in  the  19th  and  20th  chapters  of  'the 
book  of  Exodus. 

The  Jews  called  these  commandments, 
by  way  of  excellence,  the  ten  words,  from 
whence  they  had  afterwards  the  name  of 
Decalogue.  But  it  is  to  he  observed,  that 
they  joined  the  first  and  second  into  one,  and 
divided  the  last  into  two  (De  Leyih.  Eehr. 
lib.  i.  c.  2).  The  Church  of  Rome  follows 
this  divisiou :  the  Church  of  Englaud  that  re- 
cognised by  Josephus  and  the  Greek  Church. 

The  use  of  the  Decalogue  in  the  com- 
munion service,  introduced  in  1552,  is 
peculiar  to  the  English  Church.  It  is 
probably  deiived  from  the  custom  of 
reciting  and  expounding  them  at  certain 
intervals  which  is  so  frequently  enjoined  by 
the  ancient  synods,  and  the  bishops  of  the 
Church  of  England,  and  was  perhaps  also 
intended  as  a  warning  against  the  Anti- 
nomianism  of  the  age.  The  translation  in 
our  Prayer  Book  is  that  of  the  "  Great 
Bible"  of  1539-40. 

The  32nd  canon  orders  that  "the  ten 
commandments  be  set  up  on  the  east  end 
of  every  church  where  the  people  may  best 
see  them,  and  other  chosen  sentences  on 
the  walls,  ...  at  the  cost  of  the  parish." 
On  which  it  may  be  observed  that  one  of 
these  orders  is  no  more  binding  than  the 
other,  though  it  seems  often  to  be  assumed 
that  it  is.  Also  that  there  is  no  order  for 
the  Creed  and  the  Lord's  Prayer,  which 
were  generally  painted  or  inscribed  with 
the  commandments ;  but  they  have  all  be- 
come much  disused,  and  there  is  probably 
no  cathedral  where  they  appear.  In  ETiodes 
v.  Wrangham,  in  the  Consistory  Court  of 
York  in  1882,  the  plaintiff  cited  the  vicar 
for  not  painting  up  the  commandments, 
the  old  ones  having  perished  and  not  being 
replaced  in  a  restoration  of  the  church 
under  an  unopposed  faculty.  The  Chancellor 
of  York  dismissed  the  suit  with  costs  as 
jjlainly  vexatious,  and  held  that  there  was 
no  obligation  on  the  vicar  to  put  up  the 
commandments.     [H.] 


DECOEATED 

DECLARATION  (See  Cmifwmity). 

DECORATED.  This  term  is  applied  to 
the  two  styles  of  architecture,  which  lasted 
nearly  through  the  fourteenth  century,  or, 
the  reigns  of  Edward  IL  and  IIL  1307- 
1377,  between  the  Early  English  and  the 
Perpendicular.  The  great  characteristic  of 
both  of  them  is  windows  of  any  number 
of  upright  lights  (which  never  exceed  nine), 
headed  by  some  kind  of  curved  tracery, 
which  stiffened  into  almost  entirely  upright 
and  horizontal  bars  in  Perpendicular.  But 
there  are  Decorated  windows  of  one  light 
only,  hardly  distinguishable  from  Early 
English.  The  distinction  between  the  early 
or  geometrical  Decorated,  and  the  late  or 
flowing,  is  that  the  tracery  in  the  former 
windows  makes  geometrical  and  regular  and 
mostly  circular  patterns,  both  of  stone  and 
glass,  and  in  the  latter  the  stone-work  is  in 
flowing  patterns,  and  often  contains  ogee 
curves,  or  "  curves  of  contrary  flexure "  (in 
mathematical  language),  and  the  lights  have 
no  definite  patterns,  but,  as  builders  say, 
"  find  themselves,"  or  are  merely  what  the 
tracery  makes  them.  The  other  differences 
are  that  the  loose  or  "  disengaged  "  shafts 
round  Early  English  pillars  become  ''en- 
gaged," or  partly  embedded  in  the  pillars, 
and  consequently  with  horizontal  divisions 
or  beds  instead  of  distinct  long  shafts  of 
stone  or  marble.  Therefore  the  Decorated 
are  much  stronger  and  more  durable. 
Another  great  difl'erence  from  Early  English 
is  that  the  carved  foliage  becomes  "  natural," 
or  like  nature,  and  very  rich,  and  sometimes 
with  birds  and  beasts  among  the  foliage, 
instead  of  the  "  conventional,"  or  rather 
celery-stalk-looking  patterns  of  the  Early 
English,  which,  however,  was  often  very 
rich  too.  The  Decorated  mouldings  of  arches 
are  generally  smaller  and  more  numerous, , 
but  begin  to  be  deficient  in  depth  and 
strength  and  shadow.  When  Early  English 
and  Decorated  arcades  are  seen  together,  as 
at  Lichfield,  Lincoln,  or  St.  Albau's,  that  is 
very  apparent,  and  generally  also  an  inferi- 
ority in  general  proportions  ;  and  still  more 
in  the  late  than  in  the  early  Decorated.  The 
ogee  curves  are  common  in  all  later  mould- 
ings, and  have  a  weak  and  somewhat  un- 
Golhio  look,  both  there  and  in  Perpendicular. 
They  rarely  occur  in  the  early  styles. 

As  the  "  dog-tooth "  moulding  is  dis- 
tinctive of  Early  English,  so  is  the  "  ball- 
flower"  of  Decorated.  Both  are  recognised 
in  a  moment  when  seen,  and  no  description 
will  explain  them  without  seeing.  Early 
Decorated  doors  and  windows,  like  Early 
English,  generally  have  capitals  at  the  top 
of  the  side  shafts,  which  are  oftener  omitted 
in  later  Decorated  and  Perpendicular,  and 
large  double  doorways  gradually  became 
more   uncommon    as  we  leave  the  Early 


DECRETALS 

English  period ;  wliicli  is  odd,  while 
windows  grew  large)-.  In  late  Decorated 
the  mullions  and  tracery  became  altogether 
.thinner,  and  look  as  if  the  builders  wanted 
to  treat  the  stone  as  flexible ;  and  also 
shallower  from  the  outside  of  the  wall.  And 
those  two  manifest  defects  are  constantly 
imjx>rted  by  modem  architects  into  all  their 
muUioned  windows  of  every  style.  But- 
tresses became  very  deep  in  the  early 
Decorated  style,  having  been  gradually  in- 
creasing from  Norman,  which  were  little 
more  than  pilastere,  much  wider  than  their 
depth  or  projection ;  and  the  bases  and  tops 
and  set-offs  were  often  enriched  with  many 
mouldings.  Diaper  ornament  of  flat  surfaces 
was  still  used,  and  differed  very  little  from 
Early  English.  The  steeple  of  Salisbury, 
both  tower  and  spire,  which  is  incomparably 
the  finest  in  the  world,  is  of  the  early 
Decorated  style  ;  and  so  is  the  great  tower  of 
Lincoln,  which  holds  the  same  rank  among 
imspired  towers,  and  the  "Angel  choir"  of 
that  cathedral,  which  is  generally  reckoned 
our  finest  piece  of  architecture,  though 
jierhaps  the  choir  of  Ely  inside  is  as  fine. 

It  has  been  truly  said,  both  by  advocates 
of  the  superiority  of  the  early  and  of  the 
late  styles,  that  the  change  from  geometrical 
to  flowing  is  the  real  turning  point  between 
the  two  groups,  though  the  name  Decorated 
is  added  to  both  those  titles.  And  the 
late  group  is  called  by  its  admirers  Continu- 
ous and  the  earlier  Discontinuous,  as  if 
such  epithets  proved  anything  as  to  the 
merits  of  either.  The  preponderance  of 
opinion,  including  Scott  and  Rusldn,  besides 
other  writers,  is  decidedly  with  tbe  early 
Decorated,  for  reasons  they  have  given,  and 
Scott  showed  that  it  was  the  only  style  that 
was  ever  univereal,  and  that  after  reaching 
that  climax,  Gothic  architecture  divided 
again  into  different  streams  in  different 
countries.  Messrs.  Freeman  and  Petit  have 
advocated  the  later  styles,  and  still  more 
strangely,  the  Perpendicular  as  the  better  of 
those  two,  which  is  almost  universally  con- 
demned as  an  obvious  decline,  monotonous, 
stiff,  and  unimaginative.  Its  best  feature 
is  fan-vaulting,  all  the  rest  being  mere 
degradation  of  previous  freedom  and  variety 
into  monotonous  straight  lines  and  rect- 
angular pannels.     [G.] 

DECRETALS.  The  name  given  to  the 
letters  of  Popes,  being  in  answer  to  questions 
proposed  to  them  by  some  bishop  or  ecclesi- 
astical judge,  or  even  particular  person,  in 
which  they  determined  business  as  they 
thought  fit.  The  first  decretal  is  attributed 
to  Pope  Siricius,  and  dated  the  third  of  the 
Ides  of  February  under  the  consulship  of 
Arcadius  and  Bauto ;  i.e.  Feb.  11  a.d.  385. 
It  is  an  answer  to  certain  questions  which 
had    been    sent    by    Himerius,   bishop    of 


DECEETALS 


287 


Tarracona    (Newman's    Fleury,    bk.    xviii. 
XXX  i  v.). 

In  the  ninth  century  there  appeared  a 
collection  of  nearly  one  hundred  decretal 
letters  ascribed  to  more  than  thirty  Popes, 
succeeding  each  other  in  the  first  three 
centuries.  Certain  peculiarities  of  language 
indicate  that  the  collection  was  of  Frankish 
origin,  and  Mentz  is  now  commonly 
supposed  to  have  been  the  place  of  fabrica- 
tion, but  they  passed  under  the  name  of 
Isidore,  bishop  of  Seville,  a  voluminous 
writer  of  the  seventh  century  upon  whom 
an  earlier  collection  of  decretals  current  in 
Spain  had  been  fathered.  Their  uniform 
tendency  is  to  exalt  papal  power,  and 
exactly  on  those  points  for  which  no 
sanction  can  be  alleged  from  Scripture,  or 
from  the  early  periods  of  any  genuine  Church 
history ;  such  as  supreme  authority  over 
bishops,  the  receiving  appeals  from  all  part© 
of  the  world,  and  the  reservation  of  causes 
for  the  hearing  of  the  Roman  See.  In  the 
words  of  Fleury,  "They  inflicted  an  irre- 
parable wound  on  the  discipline  of  the 
Church,  by  the  new  maxims  which  they 
introduced  in  regard  to  the  judgment  of 
bishops  and  the  authority  of  the  Pope."  Dr. 
Barrow  mentions  them  among  the  chief 
causes  by  which  the  power  of  the  bishop  of 
Rome  has  been  advanced :  "  The  forgery  of 
the  decretal  epistles  (wherein  the  ancient 
popes  are  made  expressly  to  speak  and  act 
according  to  some  of  his  highest  pretences, 
devised  long  after  their  times,  and  which 
they  never  thought  of,  good  men)  did  hugely 
conduce  to  his  purpose;  authorising  his 
encroachments  by  the  suflFrage  of  ancient 
doctrine  and  practice."  "  Upon  these  spu- 
rious decretals,"  writes  Hallam,  "  was 
built  the  great  fabric  of  papal  supremacy 
over  the  different  national  Churches  :  a 
fabric  which  has  stood  after  its  foundation 
crumbled  beneath  it ;  for  no  one  has  pre- 
tended to  deny,  during  the  last  two  centuries, 
that  the  imposture  is  too  palpable  for  any 
but  the  most  ignorant  ages  to  credit " 
{Middle  Ages,  vol.  ii.  c.  7,  p.  236,  ed.  1826). 
Their  effect  was  to  magnify  the  power  and 
privileges  of  the  clergy  :  bishops  are  exempt 
from  all  secular  judgment ;  no  layman 
might  accuse  a  bishop  or  even  a  clerk ;  but 
they  tended  to  diminish  the  authority  of 
metropolitans  and  provincial  synods,  by 
allowing  to  an  accused  bishop,  not  only  the- 
right  of  appeal,  but  the  power  also  of  re- 
moving any  process  into  the  supreme  court 
at  Rome.  And  on  this  account  it  has  been 
supposed  that  the  decrees  were  forged  by 
some  bishop  who  desired  to  reduce  the  power 
of  his  immediate  superior.  But  whoever 
may  have  been  the  author,  and  whatever  the- 
origin,  there  is  no  doubt  that  the  popes 
became,  from  the  first,  their  most  strenuous 


288 


DEDICATION 


defenders.  "  The  acceptance  of  the  pseudo- 
Isidorian  statutes  established  the  great 
principle  which  Nicolas  I.  had  before  an- 
nounced of  the  sole  legislative  power  of  the 
pope.  Every  one  of  these  papal  epistles 
was  a  canon  of  the  Church ;  every  future 
bull  therefore  rested  on  the  same  in-efragable 
authority,  commanded  the  same  implicit 
obedience.  The  Pajmcy  became  a  legislative 
as  well  as  an  administrative  authority. 
Infallibility  was  the  next  inevitable  step,  if 
infallibility  was  not  abeady  in  the  power 
asserted  to  have  been  bestowed  by  the 
Lord  on  St.  Peter,  by  St.  Peter  handed  down 
in  unbroken  descent,  and  in  a  plenitude 
which  could  not  be  restricted  or  limited,  to 
the  latest  of  his  successors"  (Milman'a 
Lat.  Christ,  vol.  ii.  309.  See  also  Hook's 
Arclibishops,  i.  300).  In  the  12th  century 
Gratian  made  them  the  foundation  of  his 
Decretum,  which  became  the  standard  law- 
book of  the  Church  during  the  middle  ages. 
Accounts  of  these  forgeries  are  to  be  found 
in  the  posthumous  work  of  Van  Espen, 
Comment,  in  Jus  Novum  Canonicum,  part  ii. 
diss.  1,  p.  451-475,  and  in  Heinsohius' 
Decretales  Pseitdo- Isidorianse.  See  also 
De  Marca,  Be  Concord,  iii.  c.  4,  5,  p.  242  ; 
Natalis  Alexandri,  Hist.  Eccles.  sa3C.  i.  diss. 
13,  p.  213 ;  Coci  Censura  quorumdam 
Scriptorum,  &c.,  passim.     [H.] 

DEDICATION,  Festival  of.  I.  When 
churches  were  solemnly  dedicated  to  the 
service  of  God,  it  was  very  natmral  that  the 
anniversary  of  the  dedication  should  be 
observed.  These  anniversary  feasts  were 
called  in  ancient  times  the  Encjenia,  and 
Gregory  Nazianzen  speaks  of  them  as  an 
ancient  usage.  According  to  Sozomen  an 
anniversary  festival,  in  memory  of  the 
dedication  of  the  church  wliioh  Constantine 
built  to  the  honour  of  our  Saviour,  was 
kept  with  great  solemnity.  It  lasted  eight 
days,  during  which  time  there  were  continual 
assemblies  and  services  (Sozom.  lib.  ii.  c. 
26),  and  from  this  time  the  custom  was 
observed  in  other  churches  (Bingham,  bk. 
XX.  c.  8).  Gregory  the  Great  gave  direc- 
tions to  Mellitus,  who  was  to  take  them  to 
Augustine  in  England,  that  the  people 
should  then  have  liberty  to  erect  booths 
round  about  the  church,  and  therein  feast 
and  entertain  themselves,  in  lieu  of  their 
ancient  sacrifices  while  they  were  heathens 
(Haddan  and  Stubbs,  vol.  iii.  37).  This  is 
also  mentioned  by  Bede  (lib.  i.  c.  30).  These 
feasts,  however,  degenerated  into  licentious 
revels,  and  had  to  be  checked,  as  was  done  on 
the  continent  by  the  Council  of  Chalons,  a.d. 
650,  at  which  a  canon  was  passed  against 
the  singing  of  ribald  songs  near  the  porch  of 
the  church  on  the  dedication  festivals. 

II.  These  festivals  were  also  called 
"wakes,"  a  word  derived  probably  from 


DEDICATION 

Kyrchweiohes,  that  is,  church  feasts  (Hos- 
kin,  de  Festis,  in  appendice  de  Encseniis,  p. 
113). 

The  reason  of  the  name  is  thus  assigned 
in  an  old  manuscript:  "Ye  shall  under- 
stand and  know  how  the  evens  were  first 
founded  in  old  times.  In  the  beginning  of 
Holy  Church  it  was  so,  that  the  people 
came  to  the  chru:ch  with  candles  burning, 
and  would  wake  and  come  with  lights 
towards  night  to  the  church  in  their 
devotions:  and  after,  they  fell  to  lechery, 
and  songs,  and  dances,  harping  and  piping, 
and  also  to  gluttony  and  sin ;  and  so  turned 
the  holiness  to  cursedness.  Wherefore  the 
holy  Fathers  ordained  the  people  to  leave 
that  waking,  and  to  fast  the  even.  But  it 
is  still  called  vigil,  that  is,  waking  in 
Enghsh:  and  it  is  also  called  the  even,  for 
at  even  they  were  wont  to  come  to  church." 
It  was  in  imitation  of  the  primitive  ayanai, 
or  love  feasts  (see  Agapse"),  that  such  public 
assemblies,  accompanied  with  friendly  enter- 
tainments, were  first  held  upon  each  return 
of  the  day  of  consecration,  though  not  in 
the  body  of  churches,  yet  in  the  church- 
yards, and  most  nearly  adjoining  places. 
This  practice  was  established  in  England  by 
Gregory  ih&  Great,  as  mentioned  above. 
But  as  the  love  feasts  held  in  the  place  of 
worship  were  soon  liable  to  such  great 
disorders,  that  they  were  not  only  con- 
demned at  Corinth  by  St.  Paul,  but  pro- 
hibited to  be  kept  iu  the  house  of  God  by 
the  twentieth  canon  of  the  Council  of 
Laodicea,  and  the  thirtieth  of  the  third 
Council  of  Carthage:  so,  from  a  sense  of 
the  same  inconveniences,  this  custom  did 
not  long  continue  of  feasting  in  the  churches 
or  churchyards;  but  strangers  and  in- 
habitants paid  the  devotion  of  praj'ers  and 
offerings  in  the  church,  and  then  adjourned 
their  eating  and  drinking  to  the  more  projjer 
place  of  public  and  private  houses.  The 
institution  of  these  church  enctenia,  or 
wakes,  was,  without  question,  for  good  and 
laudable  designs:  at  first,  thankfully  to 
commemorate  the  bounty  and  munificence 
of  those  who  had  founded  and  endowed  the 
church ;  next,  to  incite  others  to  the  like 
generous  acts  of  piety;  and,  chiefly,  to 
maintain  a  Christian  spirit  of  unity  and 
charity,  by  such  sociable  and  friendly 
meetings.  And  therefore  care  was  taken  to 
keep  up  the  custom.  The  laws  of  Edward 
the  Confessor  gave  peace  and  protection 
in  all  parishes  during  the  solemnity  of 
the  day  of  dedication,  and  the  same 
privilege  to  all  that  were  going  to  or 
returning  from  such  solemnity.  In  a 
council  held  at  Oxford,  in  the  year  1222,  it 
was  ordained,  that  among  other  festivals 
should  be  observed  the  day  of  dedication  of 
every  church   within    the   proper    parish. 


DEDICATION 

And  in  a  synod  under  Archbishop  Islip 
(who  was  promoted  to  the  see  of  Canterbury 
in  the  year  1349),  the  dedication  feast  is 
mentioned  with  particular  respect.  This 
solemnity  was  at  first  celebrated  on  the  very 
day  of  dedication,  as  it  annually  returned. 
But  the  bishops  sometimes  gave  authority 
for  transposing  the  observance  to  some  other 
day,  and  especially  to  Sunday,  whereon  the 
people  could  best  attend  the  devotions  and 
rites  intended  in  this  ceremony.  Henry 
VIII.  enjoined  that  all  wakes  should  be 
kept  the  firsi  Sunday  in  October. 

This  custom  of  wakes  prevailed  for  many 
ages,  till  the  Puritans  began  to  exclaim 
against  it  as  a  remnant  of  Popery.  By 
degrees  the  humour  grew  so  popular,  that 
at  the  summer  assizes  held  at  Exeter, 
in  the  year  1627,  the  Lord  Chief  Baron 
Walter  and  Baron  Denham  made  an  order 
for  suppression  of  aU  wakes.  And  a  like 
order  was  made  by  Judge  Richardson  for 
the  county  of  Somerset,  in  the  year  1631. 
But  on  Bishop  Laud's  complaint  of  these 
innovations,  the  king  commanded  the  last 
order  to  be  reversed ;  which  Judge  Richard- 
son refusing  to  do,  an  account  was  required 
from  the  Bishop  of  Bath  and  Wells,  how 
the  said  feast  days,  church  ales,  wakes,  and 
revels,  were  for  the  most  part  celebrated  and 
observed  in  his  diocese.  On  the  receipt  of 
these  instructions,  the  bishop  sent  for  and 
advised  with  seventy-two  of  the  most 
orthodox  and  able  of  his  clergy;  who 
certified  under  their  hands,  that,  on  these 
feast  days  (which  generally  fell  on  Sundays), 
the  service  of  God  was  more  solemnly 
performed,  and  the  church  much  better 
frequented,  both  in  the  forenoon  and  after- 
noon, than  on  any  other  Sunday  in  the  year ; 
that  the  people  very  much  desired  the 
continuance  of  them;  that  the  ministers 
did  in  most  places  the  like,  for  these  reasons, 
viz.  for  preserving  the  memorial  of  the 
dedication  of  their  several  churches,  for 
civilizing  the  people,  for  composing  dif- 
ferences by  the  mediation  and  meeting  of 
fnends,  for  increase  of  love  and  luiity  by 
these  feasts  of  charity,  and  for  relief  and 
comfort  of  the  poor.  On  the  return  of  this 
certificate,  Judge  Richardson  was  again  cited 
to  the  council  table,  and  peremptorily 
commanded  to  reverse  his  former  order. 
After  which  it  was  thought  fit  to  reinforce 
the  declaration  of  King  James,  when 
perhaps  this  was  the  only  good  reason 
assigned  for  that  unnecessary  and  unhappy 
licence  of  sports:  "We  do  ratify  and 
publish  this  our  blessed  father's  decree,  the 
rather  because  of  late,  in  some  counties 
of  oar  kingdom,  we  find,  that,  imder  pre- 
tence of  taking  away  abuses,  there  hath 
been  a  general  forbidding  not  only  of 
ordinary  meetings,  but  of  the  feasts  of  the 


DEGRADATION 


289 


dedication  of  churches,  commonly  called 
wakes." 

At  the  present  time,  though  the  revelry 
of  "  wakes "  has  passed  away,  services  are 
held  in  many  churches  on  the  day  of  the 
festival  of  dedication,  and  continued  through- 
out the  octave,  in  accordance  with  the 
primitive  custom.     [H.] 

DEFENCE,  CHURCH  INSTITUTION. 
(See  Societies,  Church.) 

DEFENDER  OF  THE  FAITH.  {Fidei 
Defensor.)  A  peculiar  title  belonging  to 
the  sovereign  of  England ;  as  Catholic  to  iha 
King  of  Spain,  and,  in  the  time  of  the  Mo- 
narchy, Most  Christian  to  the  King  of 
France.  These  titles  were  given  by  the  Popes 
of  Rome.  That  of  Fidei  Defensor  was  first 
conferred  by  Pope  Leo  X.  on  King  Henry 
VIIL,  for  writing  against  Martin  Luther; 
and  the  bull  for  it  bears  date  quinto  idis 
Octobris,  1521.  It  was  afterwards  confirmed 
by  Clement  VII.  On  Henry's  suppression  of 
the  monasteries,  the  Pope  of  Rome  deprived 
him  of  tliis  title,  and  had  the  presumption 
and  absurdity  to  depose  him  from  his 
throne.  Therefore  the  title  was  conferred 
by  the  parliament  of  England,  in  the  thirty- 
fifth  year  of  Henry's  reign.  Some  antiqua- 
rians maintain  that  the  bull  of  Leo  only  re- 
vived a  title  long  borne  by  the  English  kings. 

DEGRADATION  is  an  ecclesiastical 
censure,  whereby  a  clergyman  is  deprived 
of  the  holy  orders  which  formerly  he  had, 
as  of  a  priest  or  deacon ;  and  by  the  canon 
law  this  may  be  done  two  ways,  either 
summarily  or  by  word  only,  or  solemnly, 
as  by  divesting  the  party  degraded  of  those 
ornaments  and  rights  which  were  the  en- 
signs and  order  of  his  degree. 

Collier  thus  describes  the  form  of  de- 
gradation of  a  priest,  in  the  case  of  Fawke, 
burnt  for  heresy  in  the  reign  of  Henry  IV. 
After  being  pronounced  a  heretic  relapsed, 
he  was  solemnly  degraded  in  the  following 
manner : 


/l  Priest. 


\ 


3  Sub-deacon. 


0/4  Acolyth. 


5  Exorcist. 

6  Reader. 


1  Oatiarlus,  or  Sex- 
ton. 


/ 


1.  The    paten,  chalice, 

and  pulling  off  his 
chasuble. 

2.  The  New  Testament 

and  the  stole. 

3  The    albe    and    the 

maniple. 

4  The         candlestick, 

taper,  urceolus. 

5  The  office  for  exor- 

cisms. 

6  The  lectionariura,  or 

legend  book. 
1  The     keys    of     the 
cburch-doors,     and 
Burplice. 


After  this,  Ms  ecclesiastical  tonsui'e  was 
oMiterated,  and  the  form  of  his  degrada- 
tion pronounced  hy  the  archbishop ;  and 
being  thus  deprived  of  his  sacerdotal  cha- 
racter, and  dressed  in  a  lay  habit,  he  was 
put  into   the   hands  of  the   secular  court, 


290 


DEGEEES 


•with  the  significant  request,  that  he  might 
be  favourably  received.  This  follows  very 
closely  the  old  order,  which  is  given  by 
Martene,  de  Bit.  Ant.  Eccl.,  lib.  iii.  c.  2. 

The  ancient  law  for  degradation  is  set 
forth  in  the  sixth  book  of  the  Decretals ; 
and  the  causes  for  degradation  and  depri- 
vation are  enumerated  by  Bishop  Gibson. 
(See  Gibson's  Codex,  p.  1066-1068.) 

By  Canon  122,  sentence  of  either  depri- 
vation or  degradation  "  shall  be  pronounced 
by  the  lisliop  only"  &c.  But  this  was 
expressly  decided  not  to  be  law  as  to 
deprivation  by  the  Dean  of  Arches,  in 
Sonwell  V.  Bishop  of  London  (B.  &  F.'s 
Ecc.  Gases),  whether  it  is  or  not  as  to 
degradation.  The  only  application  for 
degradation  that  we  find  in  modern  times 
was  refused  by  the  same  dean,  though  for 
a  very  gross  offence.  He  also  intimated 
that  if  it  had  to  be  done,  it  would  require 
the  piresence  of  several  bishops  as  well  as 
the  archbishop,  according  to  authorities 
older  than  the  canons  of  1603,  which  had 
no  power  to  regulate  the  proceedings  of 
the  king's  ecclesiastical  courts,  or  to  in- 
crease or  diminish  the  previous  powers  of 
either  bishops  or  judges.     [G.] 

DEGREES.  Psalms  or  Songs  of  De- 
grees is  a  title  given  to  fifteen  psalms, 
which  are  the  120th,  and  all  that  follow  to 
the  134th  inclusive.  The  Hebrew  text 
calls  them  a  song  of  ascents.  Junius  and 
TremeUius  translate  the  Hebrew,  by  a 
song  of  excellencies,  or  an  excellent  song, 
because  of  the  excellent  matter  of  them, 
as  eminent  persons  are  called  men  of  high 
degree  (1  Chron.  xvii.  17).  Some  scholars, 
as  Gesenius  and  Delitzsch,  suppose  that  the 
title  denotes  the  peouhar  rhythmical  struc- 
ture of  these  psalms,  according  to  which  a 
word  in  one  verse  is  taken  up  and  repeated 
in  the  next  in  a  kind  of  ascending  scale. 
Some  call  them  psalms  of  elevation,  because, 
they  assert,  they  were  sung  with  an  exalted 
voice ;  or  because  at  every  psalm  the  voice 
was  raised:  but  the  translation  "psalms  of 
degrees  "  has  more  generally  obtained.  Some 
inteqireters  think  that  they  were  so  called 
because  they  were  sung  upon  the  fifteen 
steps  of  the  temple ;  but  they  are  not 
agreed  about  the  place  where  these  fifteen 
steps  were.  Others  suppose  they  were  so 
called,  because  they  were  sung  in  a  gallery, 
which  they  say  was  in  the  court  of  Israel, 
where  sometimes  the  Levites  read  the  law. 
But  the  most  probable  reason  why  they  are 
called  songs  of  degrees,  or  of  ascent,  is, 
because  they  were  composed  and  sung  by 
the  Jews,  either  on  their  annual  pilgrimages 
to  keep  the  great  festival  at  Jerusalem,  or 
on  the  occasion  of  their  going  up  to  Jerusa- 
lem, after  the  deliverance  from  the  captivity 
of  Babylon,  whether  it  were  to  implore  this 


DEISTS 

deliverance  from  God,  or  to  return  thanks  for 
it  after  it  had  happened  ;  perhaps  they  were 
severally  composed  not  only  upon  this  but 
upon  other  remarkable  occasions  when  they 
made  their  ascent  to  the  temple.     [H.] 

DEGREES  in  the  universities  denote 
a  quality  conferred  on  the  students  or 
members  thereof,  as  a  testimony  of  their 
proficiency  in  the  arts  and  sciences,  and 
entitling  them  to  certain  privileges.  They 
were  first  instituted  by  Pope  Eugenius  III. 
at  the  suggestion  of  Gratian,  the  cele- 
brated compiler  of  the  canon  law  in  1151 ; 
but  were  limited  to  the  faculty  of  canon 
law,  for  the  encouragement  of  which  they 
were  instituted ;  and  consisted  of  the  ranks 
of  bachelor,  licentiate,  and  doctor.  Short- 
ly after  Peter  Lombard  instituted  similar 
degrees  in  theology  in  the  university  of 
Paris.  In  the  course  of  time  degrees  were 
given  in  other  faculties,  those  of  arts  and 
medicine  being  added.  In  many  of  the 
foreign  universities,  theology  and  canon 
law  have  each  their  three  classes  of  de- 
grees as  above  stated;  medicine  has  gene- 
rally but  two,  bachelor  and  doctor ;  and 
arts  two,  bachelor  and  master.  1'he  de- 
signation of  doctor  in  jihilosophy  is  very 
modern.  The  English  universities  have 
only  two  degrees,  bachelor  and  doctor  in 
the  superior  faculties  ;  bachelor  and  master 
in  arts.  The  degrees  both  of  bachelor  and 
master  of  arts  were  conferred  at  Oxford  m 
the  time  of  Henry  VIII.,  but  that  of  master 
of  arts  probably  much  earlier.  The  degrees 
for  Laws  are  said  to  have  come  into  the 
universities  in  1149.  Formerly  separate 
degrees  were  given  in  England  (as  abroad)  in 
canon  and  civil  law;  but  the  distinction 
ceased  in  the  seventeenth  century.  Oxford 
has  for  some  time  ceased  to  confer  degrees  in 
utroque  jure  (i.e.  civil  and  canon  law),  but 
only  in  civil  law.  Hence  her  graduates  are 
D.C.L.  and  B.C.L.,  and  not  L.L.D.  and 
L.L.B.,  as  at  Cambridge  and  Dublin.  The 
three  ancient  universities  of  England  and 
Ireland  confer  degrees  in  music. 

DEGREES,  FORBIDDEN.  (See  Affi- 
nity.) 

DEISTS.  {Deus,  God.)  Those  who 
deny  the  existence  and  necessity  of  any 
revelation,  and  profess  to  acknowledge  that 
the  being  of  a  God  is  the  chief  article 
of  their  belief.  The  same  persons  are 
frequently  called  infidels,  on  accoimt  of 
their  incredulity,  or  want  of  belief  in  the 
Christian  disijensation  of  religion. — Con- 
sult Boyle's  Lectures,  Leland's  View  of 
Deistical  Writers,  Leslie's  Sho7~t  and  Easy 
Method  with  the  Deists,  Watson's  Apology 
for  the  liihle. 

Dr.  Clarke  {Evidences  of  Nat.  and  liev. 
Jiel.  Introd.),  taking  the  word  in  its  most 
extensive  signification,  distinguishes  deists 


DEISTS 

into  four  sorts.  The  first  are,  sucli  as 
admit  the  existence  of  an  eternal,  infinite, 
independent,  intelligent  Being;  and  who, 
to  avoid  the  name  of  Epicurean  Atheists, 
teach  also,  that  this  Supreme  Being  made 
the  world ;  though,  at  the  same  time,  they 
figree  with  the  Epicm-eans  in  this,  that  they 
fancy  God  does  not  at  all  concern  himself 
in  the  government  of  the  world,  nor  has 
any  regard  to,  or  care  of,  what  is  done 
therein. 

The  second  sort  of  deists  are  those,  who 
heheve,  not  only  the  being,  bnt  also  the 
providence  of  God,  with  respect  to  the  na- 
tural world;  hut  who,  not  allowing  any 
difference  between  moral  good  and  evil, 
deny  that  God  takes  any  notice  of  the 
morally  good  or  evil  actions  of  men ;  these 
things  depending,  as  they  imagine,  on  the 
arbitrary  constitution  of  hmiian  laws. 

A  third  sort  of  deists  there  are,  who, 
having  right  apprehensions  concerning  the 
natural  attributes  of  God,  and  his  all-go- 
verning providence,  and  some  notion  of 
his  moral  perfections  also,  yet  deny  the 
immortality  of  the  human  soul,  and  believe 
that  men  perish  entirely  at  death,  and  that 
one  generation  shall  perpetually  succeed 
another,  without  any  future  restoration  or 
renovation  of  things. 

A  fourth  sort  of  deists  are  such  as 
believe  the  existence  of  a  Supreme  Being, 
together'  with  His  providence  in  the 
government  of  the  world,  as  also  all  the 
obligations  of  natural  religion ;  but  so  far 
only  as  these  things  are  discoverable  by 
the  light  of  nature  alone,  without  believing 
any  Divine  revelation. 

[To  these  must  be  added  at  least  a  fifth 
«ort,  of  whom  Carlyle  and  his  biographer 
may  be  taken  as  types,  as  they  seem 
anxious  to  inform  us ;  who  believe  '  not 
only  in  a  future  life,  but  in  some  kind  of 
judgment  and  retribution,  though  only  as  a 
matter  of  probability,  and  not  from  re- 
velation. Carlyle  distinctly  repudiated 
Christianity  and  all  certainty  about  a 
future  life,  but  nevertheless  read  the  Bible 
and  accepted  its  moral  doctrines,  though 
they  can  have  no  authority  with  such 
persons,  except  so  far  as  their  own  opinions 
agree  with  them.  Probably  no  very  de- 
finite lines  can  be  drawn  between  the 
■different  degrees  of  deism  that  exist  in 
the  world,  any  more  than  between  the 
■degrees  of  Arianism  among  those  who  have 
some  kind  of  behef  in  Jesus  Christ,  but 
none  of  His  being  the  second  person  of  the 
Trinity,  "  one  with  the  Father,"  Who  "  was 
from  the  beginning  with  God,  and  was 
God."]    [G] 

Prateolus  (Mench.  Hssres.)  mentions  a 
set  of  deists  (as  they  were  called)  which 
^sprang  up  in  Poland   in   the  year   15G4. 


DEMIURGE 


291 


They  were  a  branch  of  the  Lutherans,  and, 
coming  into  France  in  15G(),  settled  at 
Lyons.  Their  leader  (he  tells  us)  was  one 
Gregorius  Pauli,  a  minister  of  Cracow. 
They  boasted  that  God  had  bestowed  on 
them  much  greater  gifts  than  on  Luther 
and  others,  and  that  the  destruction  of 
Antichrist  was  reserved  for  them.  They 
asserted  that  there  is  one  nature,  or  Deity, 
common  to  the  Father,  Son,  and  Holy 
Ghost,  but  not  one  and  the  same  essence ; 
and  that  the  Father  alone  is  the  one  only 
true  God.  These  deists  ought  rather  to  be 
denominated  Arians. 

DELEGATES.  The  court  of  delegates 
was  so  called,  because  these  delegates  sat 
by  force  of  the  king's  commission  under  the 
gi-eat  seal,  upon  an  appeal  to  the  king  in 
the  court  of  Chancery,  in  three  causes: 
1.  When  a  sentence  was  given  in  any  eccle- 
siastical cause  by  the  archbishop  or  Ms 
ofiicial:  2.  When  any  sentence  was  given 
in  any  ecclesiastical  cause  in  places  exempt, 
i.e.  peculiars :  3.  When  a  sentence  was  given 
in  the  admiral's  court,  in  a  suit  civil  and 
marine,  by  the  order  of  the  civil  laws. 
And  these  commissioners  were  called  dele- 
gates, because  they  were  delegated  by  the 
king's  commission  for  these  purposes. 

For  the  origin  of  the  delegates  in  eccle- 
siastical appeals,  see  24  Hen.  VHL  c.  12, 
and  25  Hen.  VIII.  c.  19,  §  4.  By  the  2  & 
3  Wm.  IV.  c.  92,  the  powers  of  the  high 
court  of  delegates,  both  in  ecclesiastical  and 
maritime  causes,  were  transferred  to  her 
Majesty  in  council.  (See  Judicial  Com- 
mittee.) 

By  the  Clergy  Discipline  Act  1840  (3  &  4 
Vict.  c.  86,  s.  18)  every  bishop  of  the  Privy 
Council,  i.e.  the  archbishops  and  the  bishop 
of  London,  was  to  be  a  member  of  the  Judicial 
Committee  on  appeals  under  that  Act,  unless 
he  has  himself  sent  the  letters  of  request  or 
issued  the  commission.  The  powers  of  the 
Committee  were  further  regulated  and  ex- 
tended by  6  &  7  Vict.  c.  38,  and  7  &  8 
Vict.  c.  69,  and  14  &  15  Vict.  c.  83.  In 
1873  those  bishops  were  put  off  the  Com- 
mittee, and  in  1876  aU  the  bishops  were 
introduced  as  assessors  in  rotation,  three 
being  required  to  sit  in  every  ecclesiastical 
case,  and  five  summoned.  (See  Courts 
Christian,  and  Judicial  Committee.') 

DEMIURGE.  (From  hrjtuovpyos,  an  arti- 
ficer.) The  name  given  by  some  Gnostic 
sects  to  the  Creator  of  the  world.  Who,  ac- 
cording to  them,  was  different  from  the 
supreme  God.  (See  Gnostics.)  Valentinus 
in  the  second  century  added  to  the  fantastic 
ideas  of  the  Gnostics.  The  Demiurge  or 
Architect  of  the  world,  he  asserted,  became 
so  inflated  ^vltll  pride,  as  to  wish  men  to 
think  Him  the  only  God ;  to  repress  which 
insolence  Christ  descended.    An  account  of 

IT  2 


292 


DEMONIACS 


this  system  is  given  in  Irenseus  contra 
Hxres.  lib.  i.  c.  1-7.  (See  Valentinians ;  Bp. 
Kaye's  Tertullian,  509;  Stubbs'  Soames' 
Moslieim,  i.  148.) 

DEMONIACS.  Persons  possessed  of  the 
devil.  That  the  persons  spoken  of  in  the 
New  Testament  as  possessed  of  the  devil 
were  not  simply  lunatics,  is  clear  irom  a 
mere  perusal  of  the  facts  recorded.  The 
devils  owned  Christ  to  be  the  Messiah ; 
they  besought  Him  not  to  torment  them; 
they  passed  into  the  swine  and  drove  them 
into  the  sea.  The  manner  in  which  our 
Lord  addressed  the  demoniacs  clearly  shows 
that  they  were  really  such :  He  not  only 
rebuked  the  devils,  but  called  them  unclean 
spirits,  asking  them  questions,  commanding 
them  to  come  out,  &c.  We  find  also  that, 
for  some  time,  in  the  early  ages  of  the 
Church,  demoniacs  existed,  as  there  was  a 
peculiar  service  appointed  in  the  Church  for 
their  cure.     (See  Energuraens :  Exorcists.) 

DENAEII  DE  CAKITATE.  Customary- 
oblations,  anciently  made  to  cathedral 
churches,  about  the  time  of  Pentecost,  when 
the  parish  priests,  and  many  of  their  parish- 
ioners, went  in  procession  to  visit  their 
mother-church.  This  custom  was  after- 
wards changed  into  a  settled  due,  and  usually 
charged  upon  the  parish  priest,  though  at 
first  it  was  but  a  gift  of  cliarity,  or  present, 
towards  the  support  and  ornament  of  the 
bishop's  see. 

DENOMINATIONS,  THE  THREE. 
The  general  body  of  dissenting  ministers 
of  London  and  Westminster  form  an  as- 
sociation so  styled,  which  was  organized 
in  1727.  The  object  of  the  association 
apiiears  to  be  political.  The  Three  De- 
nominations are,  the  Presbyterian  (now 
Socinian),  Independent,  and  Baptist. 

DBNYS,  ST.,  Bishop ;  commemorated  in 
our  Calendar  October  9  :  the  patron  saint  of 
France.  He  was  sent  as  a  missionary  bishop 
(of  Paris)  in  the  third  century,  and  sufi'ered 
martyrdom  in  the  Aurelian  persecution,  circ. 
A.D.  272.  He  was  often  confused  with 
Dionysius  the  Areopagite,  the  convert  of 
St.  Paul  (Acts  xvh.  Si),  and  by  tradition 
firet  bishop  of  Athens ;  and  also  with  an- 
other Dionysius,  said  to  have  been  sent  as 
missionary  by  Clement  or  the  successors  of 
the  Apostles. — Dictionary  of  Christ.  Biog. 
s.  Y.  Dionysius ;  Barry's  P.  B.     [H.] 

DEO  GRATIAS.  {Thanhs  to  God.)  A 
form  of  salutation,  anciently  used  by  Chris- 
tians, when  they  accosted  each  other.  The 
Donatists  ridiculed  the  use  of  it ;  but  St. 
Augustine  defended  it,  affirming,  that  a 
Christian  had  reason  to  return  God  thanks 
when  he  met  a  brother  Christian.  It  is  at 
present  used  only  in  the  sacred  offices  of  the 
Roman  Church.  We  have  something  like 
it  in  the  Communion  Service  of  our  own 


DEPRIVATION 

Church,   in  which  the  minister  says,  Let  us 
give  thanks  unto  our  Zoi-d  God, 

DEPOSITION.  Theologians  and  canon- 
ists not  unfrequently  confound  deposition 
and  degradation.  While  in  the  earliest 
times  they  might  have  been  regarded  as  the 
same,  in  later  practice  there  was  a  difference 
between  the  two.  Simple  deposition  pro- 
hibited a  clerk  either  from  exercising  the 
powers  of  his  order,  or  any  ecclesiastical 
office ;  or  from  receiving  the  revenues  of  his 
benefice ;  but  it  did  not  remove  him  from 
the  spiritual  and  subject  him  to  lay  juris- 
diction. But  degradation  included  the  in- 
fliction of  all  the  penalties  which  accom- 
panied deposition,  and  committed  the  offender 
also  to  the  power  of  the  temporal  courts. 
For  a  clerk  deposed  or  degraded  to  consecrate 
the  Eucharist,  would  be  an  unlawful  act, 
and  aggravate  his  offence,  but  the  power  is 
not  taken  away,  for  "hrec  potestas  est 
simpliciter  inimpedibilis." — Maskell,  Mon. 
'Bit.  Eccl.  Ang.  vol.  ii.  clx. 

DEPRECATIONS.  Prayers  in  the  Litany 
for  deliverance  from  sjiecial  evils ;  they 
include  also  "  obsecrations "  or  prayers  for 
deliverance  from  evil  and  its  consequences, 
based  on  all  our  Lord  has  done  and  suffered 
for  mankind. — Evan  Daniel's  P.  B.  See 
Litany. 

DEPRIVATION  is  an  ecclesiastical 
sentence,  whereby  a  clergyman  is  deprived 
of  his  parsonage,  vicarage  or  other  spiritual 
promotion  or  dignity. 

By  Canon  122.  Sentence  against  a  mini- 
ster, of  deprivation  from  his  living,  "  shall 
be  pronounced  by  the  bishop  only  with  the 
assistance  of  his  chancellor  and  the  dean, 
(if  they  may  conveniently  be  had,)  and 
some  of  the  prebendaries,  if  the  conrt  be 
kept  near  the  cathedral  church ;  or  of  the 
archdeacon,  if  he  may  be  had  conveniently, 
and  two  other  at  the  least  grave  ministers 
and  preachers  to  be  called  by  the  bishop, 
when  the  court  is  kept  in  other  places."' 
But  it  is  very  doubtful  whether  that  canon 
was  not  ultra  vires.     (See  Degradation.) 

The  causes  of  deprivation  may  be  re- 
duced to  three  heads,  viis.  to  want  of 
capacity,  contempt,  and  crimes.  Noncon- 
formity is  thus  specially  punished  by- 
1  Eliz.  c.  2,  13  Eliz.  c.  12,  14  Car.  IL  c.  4. 
In  all  causes  of  deprivation,  where  a  person 
is  in  actual  posses.sion  of  an  ecclesiastical 
benefice,  these  things  must  concur :  1st,  A 
monition  or  citation  of  the  party  to  appear  : 
2nd,  A  charge  given  against  him  by  way  of 
libel  or  articles,  to  which  he  is  to  give  an 
answer :  3rd,  A  competent  time  must  be 
assigned,  for  proofs  and  interrogatories :; 
4th,  The  person  accused  .'ball  have  the 
liberty  of  counsel  to  defend  his  cause,  to. 
except  against  witnesses,  and  to  bring  legal 
proofs  against  them  :  and  5th,  There  must 


DESK 

■be  a  solemn  sentence  by  the  Dean  of  Arches, 
after  hearing  the  merits  of  the  cause,  or 
pleadings  on  both  sides.  There  is  however 
another  process  ending  in  deprivation  under 
the  Public  Worship  Act,  1874  {q.v.). 

By  1  &  2  Vict.  c.  106,  s.  31,  spiritual 
persons  trading  contrary  to  the  provisions 
of  that  Act,  may  be,  for  the  third  offence, 
•deprived  by  the  chancellor  of  the  diocese ; 
notwithstanding  the  Clergy  Discipline 
Act ;  for  it  is  held  not  to  be  an  ecclesiastical 
offence,  but  a  mere  breach  of  the  Act  which 
•created  that  sijeoial  jurisdiction  for  it. 

DESK,  CLERGY;  for  reading  prayers. 
The  eighty-second  canon  orders  among 
other  things  that  "a  convenient  seat  be 
made  for  the  minister  to  read  service  in." 
The  first  Prayer  Book,  of  1549,  ordered  "  the 
])riest  being  in  the  choir  to  begin  the  Lord's 
Prayer  "  (which  then  began  the  service) ;  in 
the  second  Prayer  Book  this  was  altered  to 
"  The  morning  and  evening  prayers  shall  be 
used'in  such  places  of  the  church  or  chancel, 
and  the  minister  shall  so  turn  him  as  the 
people  may  best  hear.  And  if  there  be  any 
controversy  therein  the  matter  shall  be  re- 
ferred to  the  ordinary,  and  he  or  his  deputy 
shall  appoint  the  place."  This  rubric  was 
altered  in  the  Elizabethan  Prayer  Book  to  the 
present  form,  that  "  the  morning  and  evening 
prayere  shall  be  used  in  the  accustomed  place 
in  the  church,  chapel  or  chancel,  except  it 
be  otherwise  ordered  by  the  ordinary."  And 
then  came  the  canon  of  1603.  For  many 
years  a  fashion  had  grown  up  of  making  a 
lower  pulpit  for  the  reading  desk  in  front  of 
the  preaching  pulpit,  which  is  also  to  be 
provided  in  "  a  convenient  place,"  by  the 
eighty-third  canon,  and  a  third  still  lower 
for  the  clerk.  The  three  together  had  come 
to  be  popularly  called  a  "  three-decker."  In 
some  town  churches  of  the  Georgian  era 
another  fashion  was  to  make  the  reading 
desk  exactly  to  match  the  pulpit  on  the 
opposite  side  of  the  "middle  aisle"  or 
passage,  for  the  benefit  of  the  galleries. 
Probably  all  these  have  been  cut  down  in 
the  last  forty  or  fifty  years,  and  the  three- 
deckers  in  the  middle  aisle  have  been 
.generally  broken  up  and  the  pulpit  removed 
■to  one  side,  and  the  clerk's  desk  abolished. 
As  a  distinct  seat  for  the  minister  is  stili 
ordered,  it  is  now  commonly  placed  at  the 
south-west  or  north-west  corner  of  the 
chancel,  and  very  often  one  at  both  corners 
to  enable  two  ministers  to  divide  the  service. 
In  some  large  cross  churches,  as  at  Don- 
-caster,  St.  Mary's,  Beverley,  &c.,  the  reading 
desk  is  placed  against  the  north-west  or 
,south-west  pier  of  the  central  tower,  as  the 
place  where  "  the  people  can  best  hear,"  and 
see  the  minister.  These  rules  do  not  apply 
■to  cathedrals  and  college  chapels  and  other 
churches    of   that    kind   with  no   distinct 


DIAPEK 


293 


chancel,  and  there  the  reading  desk  is 
commonly  behind  or  near  the  singers.     [G.] 

DBUS  MISEREATUR.  The  Latin 
name  for  Psalm  Ixvii.,  which  may  be  used 
after  the  second  lesson  at  evening  prayers, 
instead  of  the  Nunc  Dimittis,  except  on 
the  twelfth  day  of  the  month,  when  it  oc- 
curs among  the  psalms  of  the  day.  It  was 
first  inserted  in  its  present  place  in  the 
Second  Book  of  King  Edward  Vf.,  but  it 
was  familiar  in  the  older  services,  being  the 
fourth  fixed  psalm  at  Lauds  on  Sundays. 
It  was  also  part  of  the  office  of  Bidding 
Prayers  which  was  used  every  Sunday. 

DEUTERONOMY.  A  canonical  book 
of  the  Old  Testament.  The  word  implies 
a  second  law,  the  principal  design  of  it 
being,  a  repetition  of  the  laws  already  de- 
livered. It  is  the  last  book  of  the  Penta- 
teuch, or  five  books  of  Moses ;  though 
some  have  questioned  whether  it  was 
written  by  that  legislator,  because,  in  the 
last  chapter,  mention  is  made  of  his  death 
and  burial,  and  of  the  succession  of  Joshua 
after  him.  But  this  only  proves  that  the 
last  chapter  was  not  written  by  Moses,  but 
added  by  some  other  person ;  most  probably 
by  Ezra,  when  he  published  an  edition  of 
the  Holy  Scriptures.     (See  Pentateuch.') 

DEVIL.  From  AiajSoXor,  which  signi- 
fies an  accuser,  a  slanderer.  The  devil  is 
so  called  because  he  originally  accused  or 
slandered  God  in  Paradise,  as  averse  to  the 
increase  of  man's  knowledge  and  happiness  ; 
and  stiU  slandei-s  Him  by  false  and  blas- 
phemous suggestions;  and  because  on  the 
other  hand  he  is  the  accuser  of  our  brethren. 
(Parkhurst's  Diet.,  Rose's  ed.)  The  two 
words,  Devil  and  Satan,  are  used  in  Scrip- 
ture to  signify  the  same  wicked  spirit,  who 
with  many  others,  his  angels  or  under- 
agents,  is  fighting  against  God ;  and  who 
has  dominion  over  all  the  sons  of  Adam, 
except  the  regenerate. 

DIACONATE.  The  ofBce  or  order  of 
a  deacon.     (See  Deacon.) 

DIACONICUM.  (Gr.  and  Lot.)  This 
word  has  different  significations  in  eccle- 
siastical authors.  Sometimes  it  is  taken 
for  that  part  of  the  ancient  church  in  which 
the  deacons  used  to  sit  during  the  per- 
formance of  Divine  service,  namely,  at  the 
rails  of  the  altar ;  sometimes  for  a  building 
adjoining  to  the  church,  in  which  the  sa- 
cred vessels  and  habits  were  laid  up ;  some- 
times for  that  part  of  the  public  prayers 
which  the  deacons  pronounced.  Lastly,  it 
denotes  an  ecclesiastical  book,  in  which  are 
contained  all  things  relating  to  the  duty 
and  ofi&ce  of  a  deacon,  according  to  the 
rites  of  the  Greek  Church. 

DIAPER.  In  church  architecture,  a 
decoration  of  large  surfaces  with  a  con- 
stantly recurring  pattern,  either  carved  or 


294 


DIATESSAKOX 


painted.  Korman  diapers  are  usually  either 
fretted  or  zigzag  lines,  or  imbrications  of 
the  masonry;  and  not  only  plain  surfaces, 
but  pillars,  and  small  shafts,  and  even 
mouldings,  are  diapered,  as  the  cable 
moulding  surrounding  the  nave  at  Roches- 
ter. In  the  succeeding  styles,  flowers  and 
leaves  are  the  most  frequent  patterns, 
which,  in  the  Geometrical  style,  are  often 
of  extreme  beauty  and  delicacy.  After 
the  fourteenth  century,  diapers  are  painted 
only,  and  even  the  hollows  of  mouldings 
are  thus  treated.  But  diaper  is  conven- 
tionally understood  to  mean  the  dividing  of 
a  stone  surface  either  flat  or  widely  cui-ved 
into  a  reticulated  set  of  polygons  divided 
by  a  narrow  band,  each  polygon  seldom 
more  than  nine  inches  wide,  except  at  gi'eat 
elevations,  and  each  filled  up  by  a  flower  with 
leaves  approximately  fitting  it.  Some 
beautiful  examples  of  them  are  given  in 
Rickman's  Oothic  Architecture.  The  only 
polygons  that  will  fit  alone  are  squares, 
hexagons,  and  equilateral,  or  at  any  rate 
isosceles,  triangles,  which  last  however  are 
never  found.  Nor  do  we  remember  any 
old  example  of  two  polygons  being  used, 
such  as  octagons  and  a  small  square.  But 
a  pentagonal  diaper,  with  the  necessary 
trapeziums  to  fill  up,  is  used  round  the 
new  nave  pulpit  of  St.  Alban's.     [Gr.] 

DIATESSARON.  A  name  given  to  an  ar- 
rangement of  the  four  Gospels  (Sia-Tca-a-dpav) 
so  as  to  make  one  continuous  narrative. 
This  was  first  done  by  Tatian  in  the  second 
century :  but  he  is  accused  by  Busebius  of 
tampering  with  the  details,  to  suit  his  pur- 
pose {Sist.  Eccl.  iv.) ;  Theodoret  suppressed 
all  the  copies  of  the  Diatessaron  he  could 
find  in  his  churches.  {Hseres.  t.  i.  20.) 
St.  Ambrose  asserts  distinctly  that  the 
early  hannonists  did  falsify  Scripture  to 
gratify  their  own  whims.  Ammonius  of 
Alexandria  also  endeavoured  to  arrange  in 
columns  the  Gospels  (see  Ammonius 
Sections),  and  later  on  Eusebius  of  CiBsarea 
formed  his  canons  upon  these  sections. — 
Wordsworth's  GJc.  T.  vol.  i.,  xxvii. ;  Blunt's 
Theol.  Diet.  202. 

DIET.  The  assembly  of  the  states  of 
Germany.  The  most  remarkable  of  those 
which  were  held  on  the  affairs  of  religion 
were :  the  Diet  of  Worms,  in  1521,  where 
Alexander, the  Pope's  nuncio,  having  charged 
Luther  with  heresy,  the  Duke  of  Saxony 
said,  that  Luther  ought  to  be  heard; 
which  the  emperor  granted,  and  sent  him 
a  pass,  provided  he  did  not  preach  on 
this  journey.  Being  come  to  Wonns,  he 
jirotested  that  he  would  not  recant  unless 
they  would  show  him  his  errors  by  the  word 
of  God  alone,  and  not  by  that  of  men ;  where- 
fore the  emperor  soon  after  outlawed  him 
by  an  edict ;  two  diets  at  Nuremberg,  held 


DIGNITARY 

in  1523  and  1524 ;  two  at  Spire,  in  1526, 
1529 ;  four  at  Augsburg,  in  1530,  1547,. 
1548  and  1550;  and  three  at  Ratisbon. 
The  last  was  in  1557,  when  a  conference 
being  demanded  between  some  famous 
doctors  of  both  sides,  such  was  presently 
held  at  Worms  between  twelve  Lutheran 
and  twelve  Romanist  divines  :  but  it  came 
to  nothing  as  the  Lutherans  were  divided 
among  themselves.  Every  diet  above  men- 
tioned had  for  its  chief  subject  the  Lutheran 
and  Roman  question.  In  the  second  diet  of 
Spire  the  name  was  invented,  which  hag 
become  extensively  used,  that  of  Protestant : 
which  the  Lutherans  and  afterwards  the 
Calvinists  and  other  "reformed"  sects 
adopted.    (See  Augsburg,  Confession  of.) 

DIGAMY.  Second  marriages.  I.  The 
Apostolical  rule  was  that  a  bishoia  or  a  deacon 
should  be  the  husband  of  one  wife  only; 
but  with  regard  to  the  sense  and  extent 
of  that  rule  different  notions  were  held. 
Origen,  Tertullian,  and  many  other  early 
writers,  held  that  all  persons  were  to  be 
refused  orders  who  were  twie«  married  after 
baptism ;  and  this  sense  was  put  on  St. 
Paul's  words,  by  the  councils  of  Agde  and 
Carthage.  (Grig.  Horn.  17  in  Luc. ;  Tei-tuU. 
de  Monogam.  c.  ii.  &c. ;  Ambrose,  de  Offic. 
i.  501.)  Some  indeed  even  put  a  stricter 
interpretation  on  the  rale,  and  forbad  ordi- 
nation to  all  who  had  been  twice  married, 
whether  before  or  after  baptism.  On  the 
other  hand  the  opinion  was  sometimes  held 
that  the  Apostolic  rule  was  directed  against 
polygamists,  and  those  who  married  again 
after  being  divorced.  (See  St.  Chrysost. 
Horn.  10 ;  in  1  Tim.  iii.  2 ;  in  Tit.  i.  6.) 
Canons  at  many  councils  were  passed  against 
digamy,  although  it  was  sometimes  allowed 
among  the  inferior  clergy.  (See  Smith  and 
Cheetham's  Diet.  Ecc.  Ant.  s.  v.) 

II.  The  Canons  of  Neo-Caisarea,  Laodicea, 
and  St.  Basil  debarred  those  who  mamed  a 
second  time  from  communion  for  one  of 
two  years ;  but  Bingham  is  of  the  opinioa 
that  the  object  of  these  canons  was  to  dis- 
countenance marrying  after  an  unlawful 
divorce,  (iv.  v.  4 :  xv.  iv.  18).  The  re- 
marriage of  divorced  persons  has  always 
been  opposed  by  the  Church,  on  the  au- 
thority of  our  Lord  himself ;  but  by  the  law  of 
England  it  is  allowed.  (See  Divorce.)  [H.] 
DIGNITARY.  One  who  holds  any  pre- 
ferment to  which  jurisdiction  is  aunexedi 
The  dignitaries  in  British  cathedrals  are, 
for  the  most  part,  the  dean,  precentor,  chan- 
cellor, treasurer,  and  archdeacon.  Some- 
times the  subdean  and  succentor  canoni- 
corum  are  so  called ;  and  in  a  few  churches 
in  Ireland,  the  provost  and  sacrist  (or  trea- 
surer). The  only  dignitary  in  cathedrals  of 
the  new  foundation  is  the  dean ;  as  the 
archdeacon  is  not  necessarily  a  member  of 


DILAPIDATIOX 

such  chapters.  (See  Cathedral.)  It  is  a 
vulgar  error  to  style  prebendaries,  or  canons 
residentiary,  dignitaries.  The  prebendaries 
without  dignity  were  styled  canonict  (or 
prehendarii)  simplices. — Jebb  on  the  Choral 
Service,  p.  27-50. 

DILAPIDATION.  The  ruin  or  decay  of 
the  chancel  or  any  other  edifice  of  his 
ecclesiastical  living,  which  has  been  caused 
by  the  incumbent's  neglect  to  repair  the 
same ;  and  it  likewise  extends  to  his  com- 
mitting, or  suffering  to  be  committed,  any 
wilful  waste  in  or  upon  the  glebe,  woods,  or 
any  inheritance  of  the  church,  which  includes 
working  mines,  unless  the  profits  are  in- 
vested for  the  benefit  of  the  living,  and  even 
cutting  down  trees  unless  for  repairs  of  the 
property ;  and  the  specific  timber  need  not 
be  used,  but  only  the  value  of  it:  and 
altering  houses  without  a  faculty,  so  as  to 
make  them  less  suitable  for  the  hving.  The 
present  law  of  dilapidations  dei^ends  mxin 
an  Act  passed  in  1871,  and  amended  in 
1872  as  usual,  which  has  been  described  as 
"  got  up  by  two  or  three  bishops  who  did  not 
imderstand  what  they  were  doing,  and  two 
or  three  surveyors  who  did,"  and  it  has  been 
absolutely  condemned  by  a  Committee  of  the 
House  of  Commons  in  1876,  and  yet  remains 
unrepealed.  The  reasons  given  for  it  were 
that  clergymen  sometimes  die  insolvent, 
which  no  Act  of  Parliament  is  likely  to  pre- 
vent, and  that  they  did  not  always  spend 
the  money  they  received  for  dilapidations  in 
doing  the  repairs,  for  which  there  had  been 
a  legal  remedy  ever  since  14  Eliz.  c.  11, 
s.  6,  under  a  penalty  of  forfeiting  twice  the 
value,  of  which  the  authors  of  the  new  Acts 
apparently  knew  nothing.  The  substance 
of  them  is  as  follovrs :  Diocesan  surveyors 
are  to  be  appointed  who  are  to  have  the 
benefit  of  surveying  every  bit  of  property 
subject  to  dilapidation  on  every  vacancy, 
and  to  be  paid  by  fees  and  not  hy  salary ; 
instead  of  leaving  people  to  settle  their  own 
claims  as  before.  If  the  outgoing  parson 
has  left  money  enough  to  pay  the  valuation 
it  is  paid  as  before ;  but  if  he  does  not,  the 
new  one  is  bound  at  once  to  do  the  reiaairs 
at  his  own  expense  whether  he  wants  them 
or  not.  The  surveyors'  fees  are  to  be  fixed 
(by  the  1873  Act)  by  no  less  machinery 
than  the  two  archbishops,  the  Lord  Chan- 
cellor, the  two  archiepiscopal  vicars-general, 
the  Lords  of  the  Treasury  and  the  Queen  in 
Council.  The  surveyor  is  to  inspect  and 
report  as  soon  as  conveniently  may  be,  and 
report  to  the  bishop  and  to  send  a  copy  to 
the  new  incumbent  and  the  executors  of  the 
old  one  of  what  works  are  needed  and  an 
estimate  of  their  cost,  and  their  special  cir- 
cumstances. Either  party  may  object  if  he 
likes  to  waste  his  money  in  having  a  second 
inspection  made  at  his  own  expense   by 


DIOCESE 


295 


some  competent  person  (who  may  be  the 
same  surveyor),  or  have  a  case  laid  before 
counsel,  on  which  the  bishop  is  to  give  las 
decision  in  writing;  all  which  means  more 
fees  to  more  officials.  He  may  borrow  for 
repairs  as  much  as  Queen  Anne's  Boimty  will 
lend,  up  to  three  years'  value,  with  consent 
of  the  bishop  and  the  patron,  on  security  of 
the  benefice,  as  for  building  a  new  vicarage, 
and  must  pay  the  dilapidation  money  to 
Q.  A.  B.,notsimply  receive  it  from  his  prede- 
cessor as  before,  and  spend  it  himself;  i.e.  he 
is  to  pay  it  whether  he  has  i-eceived  it  or  not, 
and  Q.  A.  B.  is  to  jiay  the  builder.  And 
when  the  repairs  are  done  there  is  to  be  "  a 
certificate  in  triplicate "  delivered  by  the 
surveyor  to  Q.  A.  B.,  the  bishop's  registry, 
and  the  incumbent.  And  an  incumbent 
may  do  the  same  at  any  time,  with  this 
singular  jirovision,  that  such  a  certificate 
warrants  the  house  good  for  five  years :  i.e. 
that  if  he  vacates  it  within  that  time,  by  a 
day,  no  dilapidations  can  be  recovered  how- 
ever bad  it  may  have  become.  That 
scheme  was  invented  to  tempt  incumbents  to 
repair.  All  incumbents  are  required  to  insure 
for  at  least  three-fifths  of  tlie  value  of  the 
house ;  but  that  does  not  protect  them  from 
having  to  rebuild  if  the  house  is  burnt 
down,  nor  does  the  insurance  money  go  to 
the  incumbent,  but  to  Q.  A.  B.  Another  of 
the  pleasing  consequences  of  this  Act  for  the 
benefit  of  clergy  is  that  if  the  "  dilapida- 
tor "  (as  they  call  these  surveyors)  takes  it 
into  his  head  that  some  bygone  architectural 
feature  of  a  house  which  nobody  has  wanted 
for  centuries  ought  to  be  "  restored,"  he  may 
order  it,  whatever  it  costs.  And  so  much 
did  the  authors  of  the  Act  know  of  the 
existing  law  that  they  put  in  a  special 
clause  to  authorise  the  bishop  to  do  exactly 
what  could  be  done  before  by  a  faculty,  viz. 
to  remove  unnecessary  buildings.  The  sole 
merit  of  the  Act,  compared  with  some  other 
bad  ones,  is  that  it  has  not  destroyed  any 
ancient  jurisdictions,  and  so  only  needs 
repealing  by  a  single  clause,  as  the  Com- 
mittee of  the  House  of  Commons  recom- 
mended.    [G.] 

DIMISSORY  LETTERS.  (See  Letters 
Dimissory.) 

DIOCESE.  The  area  of  a  bishop's  juris- 
diction. A  province  is  the  area  of  an 
archbishop's  jurisdiction.  Each  province 
contains  divers  dioceses,  or  sees  of  suffragan 
bishops;  whereof  Canterbury  now  includes 
twenty-three  and  York  eight.  (See  Arch- 
bishops.) Every  diocese  in  England  is  divided 
into  archdeaconries,  and  each  archdeaconry 
into  rural  deaneries,  and  every  deanery  into 
parishes. 

The  division  of  the  Church  into  dioceses 
may  be  viewed  as  a  natural  consequence  of 
the  institution  of  the  office  of  bishops.     The 


■296 


DIOCESE 


authority  to  exercise  jui-isdiction,  when 
committed  to  several  hands,  requires  that 
some  boundaries  he  defined  within  which 
each  party  may  employ  his  powers ;  other- 
wise disorder  and  confusion  would  ensue, 
and  the  Church  instead  of  being  benefited 
by  the  appointment  of  governors,  might 
be  exposed  to  the  double  calamity  of  an 
overplus  of  them  in  one  district,  and  a  total 
deficiency  of  them  in  another.  Hence  wo 
find,  so  early  as  tiie  New  Testament  history, 
Fome  plain  indicarions  of  the  rise  of  the 
diocesan  system  in  the  cases  respectively 
of  James,  bishop  of  Jerusalem ;  Timothy, 
bishop  of  Ephesus ;  Titus,  of  Crete ;  to 
whom  may  be  added  the  "angels  "  or  bishops 
of  the  seven  Churches  in  Asia.  These  were 
placed  in  cities,  and  had  jurisdiction  over  the 
churches  and  inferior  clergy  in  those  cities, 
and  probably  in  the  country  adjacent.  The 
first  dioceses  were  formed  by  planting  a 
bishop  in  a  city  or  considerable  village, 
where  he  officiated  regularly,  and  took  the 
spiritual  charge,  not  only  of  the  city  itself, 
but  of  the  suburbs,  or  region  lying  round 
about  it,  within  the  verge  of  its  [civil]  juris- 
diction ;  which  seems  to  be  the  plain  reason 
of  that  great  and  visible  difference  which 
we  find  in  the  extent  of  dioceses,  some 
being  very  large,  others  very  small,  according 
as  the  civil  government  of  each  city  happened 
to  have  a  larger  or  lesser  jurisdiction. 

In  England,  after  the  landing  of  Augustme 
in  597,  the  several  kingdoms  were  gradually 
converted  to  Christianity  during  nearly  a 
century  according  as  missionaries  obtained 
opportunities;  though  it  must  not  be  for- 
gotten that  the  British  Church  flourished 
previously,  and  the  Church  of  St.  Alban's 
existed  214  years  before.  (See  Church, 
■Early  British.)  The  first  apostle  of  the 
■faith  in  each  kingdom  generally  became 
the  first  bishop.  His  see  was  commonljr 
fixed  in  or  near  any  place  where  he  was  first 
permitted  to  begin  his  labours,  and  his 
diocese  was  as  a  rule  coextensive  with  the 
kmgdom.  If  the  size  of  the  kingdom 
increased,  as  in  the  case  of  Wessex,  the 
dioceses  were  multiplied.  In  the  Church  of 
'England  her  dioceses,  compared  with  the 
population,  are  still  too  extensive  and  too 
■few.  It  is  impossible  for  our  bishops  to  per- 
form, all  their  canonical  duties,  such  as 
visiting  annually  every  parish  in  the  diocese, 
inspecting  schools,  Divine  service,  instruction, 
&c.,  besides  baptizing,  confirming,  consecrat- 
ing. Episcopal  extension,  as  well  as  Church 
extension,  is  most  important,  a  truth  which 
has  now  been  practically  recognised.  The 
'dioceses  of  St.  Alban's,  Liverpool,  Truro, 
Newcastle,  and  Southwell,  have  been  formed 
lately,  and  endowed  by  the  liberality  of 
Churchmen;  and  at  least  two  others  are  in 
'contemplation. 


DIOCESAN 

The  bishops  liave  always  sat  in  Parliament 
by  virtue  of  their  official  rank' — not  as  barons 
of  the  realm.  (See  Stubbs'  Constit.  Hist. 
i.  357 ;  ii.  169  ;  iii.  443.)  The  beginning  of 
a  new  system  was  made  on  the  erection  of 
the  see  of  Manchester,  in  1847,  since  which 
time  only  the  26  senior  bishops,  including  the 
5  with  special  precedence,  have  seats  in  the 
House  of  Lords. 

DIOCESAN.  A  bishop,  as  he  stands 
related  to  his  diocese.     (See  Bishop.') 

DIPPERS.     (See  DunUrs.) 

DIPPING.     (See'  Immersion;  Baptism.) 

DIPTYCH.  A  book,  or  register  in  which 
were  inscribed  the  names  of  those  who  were 
to  be  commemorated  or  ibr  whom  prayers 
were  to  be  offered.  It  was  called  diptych 
{biTrrv^os)  from  its  being/oZifec?  together,  and 
it  was  the  deacon's  office  to  recite  the  names 
written  in  it,  as  occasion  required.  The 
names  of  the  "  competentes "  who  had  been 
accepted,  and  baptized,  were  written  down ; 
and  in  the  Council  of  Constantinople  (4.  can. 
84)  mention  is  made  of  an  officer  whose 
duty  it  was  thus  to  register  them.  The 
registers  were  called  diptychs,  but  to  dis- 
tinguish them  from  other  diptychs,  they 
were  particularly  called  Siirrvx"-  C^vrav 
(Packhymer  in  Dionys.  p.  234).  The  diptych 
generally  contained  the  names  of  sovereigns, 
prelates,  patriarchs,  and  holy  men  who  had 
deserved  well  of  the  Church ;  and  also  of 
departed  saints,  especially  such  as  had  been 
in  connexion  with  the  particular  place. 
Some  distiuguisli  three  sorts  of  diptychs: 
one,  wherein  the  names  of  bishops  only 
were  written,  such  especially  as  had  been 
governors  of  that  particular  church ;  a 
second,  in  which  the  names  of  the  living 
were  written,  such  in  jjarticular  as  were 
eminent  for  any  office  or  dignity,  or  some 
benefaction  and  good  work,  in  which  rank 
were  bishops,  emperors,  and  magistrates ; 
lastly,  a  third,  containing  the  names  of  such 
as  were  deceased  in  Catholic  communion. — 
Bona,  Eer.  Liturg.  lib.  ii.  c.  12. 

Theodoret  (lib.  v.  c.  34),  mentions  these 
kinds  of  registers  in  relation  to  the  case  of  St. 
Ohrysostom,  whose  name,  for  some  time, 
was  left  out  of  the  diptychs,  because  he  died 
under  the  sentence  of  excommunication, 
pronounced  against  him  by  Theophilus, 
bishop  of  Alexandria,  and  other  Eastern 
bishops,  with  whom  the  Western  Church 
would  not  communicate  until  they  had  re- 
placed his  name  in  the  diptychs ;  for,  to 
erase  a  person's  name  out  of  these  books  was 
the  same  thing  as  declaring  him  to  have 
been  an  heretic,  or  some  way  deviating  from 
the  faith. — Bingham,  xv.  iii.  (For  a  full 
account  see  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  p.  560.)    [H.] 

DIOCESAN  SOCIETIES.  In  abnost 
every  diocese  there  is  a  society  for  collecting 
and  distributing  funds  for  the  furtherance  of 


DIRECTORY 

cliurcli  work.  Grants  are  made  (a)  for  build- 
ing and  restoring  churches ;  (/3)  for  building 
parsonage  houses ;  (-y)  for  augmenting  very 
poor  livings.  (See  Official  Year  Book,  G.  of 
E.  1886,  p.  24.) 

DIRECTORY.  A  kind  of  regulation  for 
the  performance  of  religious  worship,  drawn 
up  by  the  Assembly  of  Divines  in  England, 
at  the  instance  of  the  parliament,  in  the 
year  16i4.  It  was  designed  to  su|)ply  the 
place  of  the  Liturgy,  or  Book  of  Common 
Prayer,  the  use  of  which  the  parliament 
had  abolished.  It  consisted  only  of  some 
general  heads,  which  were  to  be  managed 
and  filled  up  at  discretion ;  for  it  prescribed 
no  form  of  prayer  or  circumstances  of 
external  worship,  nor  obliged  the  people  to 
any  responses,  excepting  Amen.  The  use 
of  the  Directory  was  enforced  by  an 
ordinance  of  the  Lords  and  Commons  at 
Westminster,  which  was  repeated  August 
3rd,  1645.  By  this  injunction,  the  Direc- 
tory was  ordered  to  be  dispersed  and  pub- 
lished in  all  parishes,  chapelries,  donatives, 
&c.  The  use  of  the  Prayer  Book  was 
forbidden  even  in  private.  All  copies  were 
to  be  given  up,  and  persons  who  violated 
these  ordinances  were  to  be  heavily  fined. 
"  It  was  a  crime  in  a  child, "  says  Lord 
Macaulay,  "  to  read  by  the  bedside  of  a  sick 
parent  one  of  those  beautiful  collects  which 
had  soothed  the  griefs  of  forty  generations 
of  Christians."  (^Hist.  i.  167.)  In  opposi- 
tion to  this  injunction,  Kins  Charles  issued 
a  proclamation  at  Oxford,  November  13th, 
1645,  enjoining  the  use  of  the  Common 
Prayer  according  to  law,  notwithstanding 
the  pretended  ordinances  for  the  new  Direc- 
toiy. 

To  give  a  short  abstract  of  the  Directory : 
•It  forbids  all  salutations  and  civil  ceremony 
in  the  churches.  The  reading  the  Scripture 
in  the  congregation  is  declared  to  be  part  of 
the  pastoral  office.  All  the  canonical  books 
of  the  Old  and  New  Testament  (but  none  of 
the  Apocrypha}' a,Te  to  be  publicly  read  in 
the  vulgar  tongue.  How  large  a  portion  is 
to  be  read  at  once  is  left  to  the  minister, 
who  has  likewise  the  liberty  of  expounding, 
when  he  judges  it  necessary.  It  prescribes 
heads  for  the  prayer  before  sermon ;  among 
which  part  of  the  prayer  for  the  king  is,  to 
save  him  from  eoil  counsel.  It  delivers  rules 
for  managing  the  sermon ;  the  introduction 
to  the  text  must  be  short  and  clear,  drawn 
from  the  words  or  context,  or  some  parallel 
place  of  Scripture ;  in  dividing  the  text,  the 
minister  is  to  regard  the  order  of  the  matter 
.more  than  that  of  the  words;  he  is  not  to 
burden  the  memory  of  his  audience  with  too 
many  divisions,  nor  perplex  their  under- 
standings with  logical  phrases  and  terms  of 
art ;  he  is  not  to  start  unnecessary  objections  ; 
and  he  is  to  be  very  sparing  in  citations 


DISCIPLE 


297 


from  ecclesiastical,  or  other  human  writers, 
ancient  or  modern. 

The  Directory  recommends  the  use  of  the 
Lord's  Prayei-,  as  the  most  perfect  model  of 
devotion.  It  forbids  private  or  lay  persons 
to  administer  baptism,  and  enjoins  it  to  be 
performed  in  the  face  of  the  congregation. 
It  orders  the  communion  table  at  the  Lord's 
supper  to  bo  so  placed  that  the  communi- 
cants may  sit  about  it.  The  dead,  according 
to  the  rules  of  the  Directory,  are  to  be  buried 
without  any  prayers  or  religious  ceremony. 

The  Iloman  Catholics  publish  an  annual 
Directory  for  their  laity,  which  serves  the 
purpose  of  a  book  of  reference  in  matters 
of  ceremonial  as  settled  by  tlieir  com- 
munion.— Broughton,  Bihlio.  Annot.  P.  B. 
207. 

DIRGE.  I.  The  ofiTCe  for  the  dead.  It 
derives  its  name  from  the  opening  words  of 
the  antiphon,  "Dirige  in  conspectu  tuo 
viam  meam "  (Ps.  v.  8),  and  was  contained 
in  the  ancient  Breviaries,  and  in  the  English 
Prymers  (see  Prymer').  The  office  was 
also  called  the  "  Placebo, "  from  the  antiphon 
"Placebo  Domino,"  or  the  "placebo  and 
dirge;"  and  other  names  are  given  to  it  in 
the  old  books.  But  in  the  Prymers  of  1538, 
1543,  and  the  King's  Prymer,  it  is  called 
only  the  dirge.  The  ofiice  consisted  of  two 
parts;  the  evensong  or  vespers,  and  the 
matins;  but  at  first  it  had  vespers  onlj'. 
Tlie  ancient  rule  in  England  was  that  it 
should  be  said  frequently  by  the  regular 
clergy,  and  those  attached  to  cathedrals, 
but  this  was  not  invariable  (see  Dugdale, 
Monast.  Any.  vol.  vi.  p.  706).  It  is  not 
known  by  whom  it  was  originally  composed. 
By  some  it  is  said  that  it  dates  from  the 
Apostolic  age,  and  was  added  to  by  Origen ; 
by  others  it  is  attributed  to  St.  Augustine 
or  to  St.  Ambrose.  But  on  one  point  all 
agree :  that  it  is  of  the  highest  antiquity, 
and  was  used  in  the  earliest  ages  of  the 
Church. — Maskell,  Mon.  Pit.  iii.  115. 

II.  In  modern  usage  the  word  implies  a 
solemn  song  or  chant,  to  express  grief  and 
mourning  for  the  dead.     [H.] 

DISCIPLE,  literally  a  "learner,"  from 
"  discere,"  to  learn.  Hence  the  followers  of 
any  teacher,  philosopher,  or  head  of  a  sect, 
are  usually  called  his  disciples.  In  the  Chris- 
tian sense  of  the  term,  disciples  are  the 
followers  of  Jesus  Christ  in  general  ; 
but,  in  a  more  restricted  sense,  it  denotes 
those  who  were  the  immediate  followers 
and  attendants  on  His  person.  The  names 
disciple  and  apostle  are  not  convertible  terms  : 
the  apostles  were  persons  selected  out  of  the 
number  of  disciples,  and  commissioned  or 
"  sent  forth "  (from  aTroo-Tf'XXetf)  to  be  the 
principal  ministers  of  His  religion.  Thus  all 
apostles  were  disciples,  but  all  disciples  were 
not  apostles.     Of  these  there  were  twelve; 


298 


DISCIPLINE 


whereas  those  who  aie  simply  styled  dis- 
ciples were  seventy,  or  seventy-two,  in 
number.  St.  Paul  indeed  was  not  a  follower 
of  our  Lord  whilst  he  was  on  earth,  hut  he 
too  became  a  disciple  before  he  was  an 
apostle.  There  was  not  as  yet  any  catalogue 
of  the  disciples  in  Eusebius's  time,  i.e.  in  the 
fourth  century.  The  Latins  kept  the  festival 
of  the  seventy  or  seventy-two  disciples  on 
the  15th  of  July,  and  the  Greeks  on  the  4th 
of  January. 

DISCIPLINE,  ECCLESIASTICAL.  The 
Christian  Church  being  a  spiritual  com- 
munity or  society  of  persons  professing 
the  religion  of  Jesus,  and,  as  such,  governed 
by  spiritual  or  ecclesiastical  laws,  her  dis- 
ciphne  consists  in  putting  those  laws  in 
execution,  and  inflicting  the  penalties  en- 
joined by  them  against  several  sorts  of 
offenders.  To  understand  the  true  nature 
of  church  discipline,  we  must  consider  how 
it  stood  in  the  ancient  Christian  Church. 
And,  first. 

The  primitive  Church  never  pretended 
to  exercise  discipline  upon  any  but  such 
as  were  within  her  pale,  in  the  largest 
sense,  by  some  act  of  their  awn  profession ; 
and  even  upon  these  she  never  pretended 
to  exercise  her  discipline  so  far  as  to  cancel 
or  disannul  their  baptism.  But  the  disci- 
pline of  the  Church  consisted  in  a  power 
to  deprive  men  of  the  benefits  of  external 
communion,  such  as  public  prayer,  receiv- 
ing the  Eucharist,  and  other  acts  of  Divine 
worship.  This  power,  before  the  establish- 
ment of  the  Church  by  human  laws,  was  a 
mere  spiritual  authority,  or,  as  St.  Cyprian 
terms  it,  a  spiritual  sword,  affecting  the 
soul,  and  not  the  body.  Sometimes,  in- 
deed, the  Church  craved  assistance  from 
the  secular  power,  even  when  it  was  hea- 
then, but  more  frequently  after  it  was  be- 
come Christian.  But  it  is  to  be  observed, 
that  the  Church  never  encouraged  the 
magistrate  to  proceed  against  any  one  tor 
mere  error,  or  ecclesiastical  misdemeanour, 
further  than  to  punish  the  delinquent  by 
a  pecuniary  mulct,  or  bodily  punishment, 
such  as  confiscation  or  banishment;  and 
St.  Augustine  aflSrms,  that  no  good  men  in 
the  Catholic  Church  were  pleased  that 
heretics  should  be  prosecuted  unto  death. 
Lesser  punishments,  they  thought,  might 
have  their  use,  as  means  sometimes  to  bring 
them  to  consideration  and  repentance. 

Nor  was  it  a  part  of  the  ancient  disci- 
pline to  deprive  men  of  their  natural  or 
civil  rights.  A  master  did  not  lose  his 
authority  over  his  family,  a  parent  over 
his  children,  nor  a  magistrate  his  office  and 
charge  in  the  state,  by  being  cast  out  of 
the  Church.  But  the  discipline  of  the 
Church  being  a  mere  spiritual  power,  was 
confined   to,  1.  The  admonition  of  the  of- 


DISESTABLISHMENT 

fender ;   2.  The  lesser  and  greater  excom-- 
munication. 

As  to  the  objects  of  ecclesiastical  disci- 
pline, they  were  all  such  delinquents  as- 
fell  into  great  and  scandalous  crimes  after 
baptism,  whether  men  or  women,  priests 
or  people,  rich  or  poor,  princes  or  subjects. 
That  princes  and  magistrates  fell  under 
the  Church's  censures,  may  be  proved  by 
several  instances ;  particularly  St.  Chry- 
sostom  relates,  that  Bahylas  denied  com- 
munion to  one  of  the  Eoman  emperors  odj 
account  of  a  barbarous  murder  committed 
by  him  (Chrysos.  de  Bah.  sive  cont.  Gentiles, 
vol.  L)  :  St.  Ambrose  likewise  denied  com- 
munion to  Maximus  for  shedding  the  blood 
of  Gratian;  and  the  same  holy  bishop  ab- 
solutely refused  to  admit  the  emperor 
Theodosius  the  Great  into  his  church,  not- 
withstanding his  humblest  entreaties,  be- 
cause he  had  inhumanly  put  to  death  7000 
men  at  Thessalonica,  without  distinguishing 
the  innocent  from  the  guilty. — Ambrose, 
Ep.  30  ad  Val.  Jun.  Theod.  lib.  v.  c.  18. 
(See  Clergy,  Eegidations  of.) 

DISESTABLISHMENT  OP  THE 
CHUECH.  I.  Ireland.  Without  discuss- 
ing the  excuses  that  were  made  for  that  act 
of  robbery  in  1869,  it  is  appropriate  to  this 
work  to  explain  what  it  was  and  did, 
especially  as  Acts  of  Parliament  are  not 
easily  accessible  to  those  who  have  not  law 
libraries  to  resort  to.  It  is  worth  notice 
that  "  Disestablishment "  ipso  facto  meant 
disendowment,  for  the  title  of  the  Act  is 
only  "  An  Act  to  put  an  end  to  the  establish- 
ment of  the  Church  in  Ireland  " ;  and  s.  2 
simply  did  so.  But  then  immediately 
begins  disendowment,  or  confiscation  for 
purely  secular  purposes,  as  will  be  seen 
farther  on.  S.  3  appointed  three  "  Com- 
missioners of  Church  Temporalities,"  i.e. 
property,  with  power  to  the  Crown  to  fill 
up  vacancies ;  and  they  were  (s.  7)  to  have 
full  powers  to  decide  all  questions  of  law  and 
fact  without  appeal,  except  that  an  arbitra- 
tion may  be  demanded  on  questions  of 
value  (s.  42).  All  property  belonging  to 
any  ecclesiastical  person  or  coi^poration  of 
the  Church,  including  the  Ecclesiastical 
Commissioners  for  Ireland,  except  what 
was  held  on  private  trusts,  was  vested  in 
the  Church  Commissioners  (ss.  11,  12). 
(Observe,  it  does  not  any  property  of  the 
Church,  for  the  Church  as  a  whole  has  none, 
though  the  Dissenters  are  in  the  habit  of 
saying  that  it  has.)  Every  ecclesiastical 
corporation  sole  or  aggregate  was  dissolved, 
and  the  bishops,  even  the  existing  ones, 
tm-ned  out  of  Parliament,  but  allowed  to 
keep  their  titles  and  their  precedence  for 
life  (s.  13).  And  there  was  an  Order  in 
Council  in  April,  1885,  giving  the  same 
precedence  to  future  archbishops  andbisho];« 


DISESTABLISHMENT 

of  "  the  Protestant  Episcopalian  Cliureh," 
and  to  those  of  the  Koman  Cliurch  in 
Ireland,  as  those  of  the  Irish  Church  had 
formeily,  and  inter  se  according  to  their 
dates  of  consecration,  the  primates  or  aroli- 
bishops  of  each  having  precedence  as  before ; 
but  that  was  not  to  interfere  with  the  prece- 
dence reserved  by  the  Act  to  the  then 
existing  bishops. 

By  s.  14:  the  existing  holders  of  all  clerical 
preferment  were  to  receive  for  life  their 
previous  net  income  so  long  as  they  con- 
tinued to  discharge  their  previous  spiritual 
duties,  or  such  as  might  be  substituted  for 
them  by  the  then  created  "  representative 
body "  of  the  Church,  unless  they  were 
permanently  disabled.  By  s.  15  the  Com- 
missioners were  also  to  give  annuities  to 
curates  whom  they  might  "  deem  to  have 
been  permanent,"  according  to  circumstances, 
so  long  as  they  also  did  their  duties,  or  only 
failed  to. do  so  from  disability  ;  and  might 
also  grant  to  any  that  they  did  not  deem 
permanent,  compensation  at  the  rate  of  £25 
for  every  year  that  they  had  served,  but  in 
no  case  to  exceed  £600.  S.  16  provides  for 
annuities  to  compensate  Church  school- 
masters, clerks,  and  sextons,  and  other 
undefined  officers,  so  long  as  they  also 
discharged  their  duties ;  and  the  Com- 
missioners were  also  to  commute  such 
annuities  for  lump  sums  if  required.  Then 
comes  this  important  clause  (18)  as  to  the 
agitated  question  of  the  sale  of  preferment : 
The  Commissioners  were  to  compensate  all 
private,  i.e.  non-official,  owners  of  ad vo wsons 
and  presentations,  whether  corporate  or 
individual. 

The  future  government  of  the  Church  is 
provided  for  as  follows  : — By  s.  19  all  legal 
prohibitions  of  synods  or  conventions  are 
repealed;  but  (s.  20)  the  present  eccle- 
siastical law  of  Ireland,  and  the  articles, 
doctrines,  rites,  rules,  discipline,  and  ordi- 
nances of  the  Church  are  to  remain,  subject 
to  such  modifications  as  may  be  made 
therein  from  time  to  time  in  the  manner  to 
be  settled  by  the  representative  body  and  its 
charter ;  and  the  same  shall  be  enforced  when 
necessary  by  the  temporal  courts  (as  they 
are  for  Dissenters),  and  the  ecclesiastical 
courts  were  abolished,  which,  by  the  bye, 
had  been  legislated  for  a  few  years  before  a 
great  deal  better  than  the  English  ones. 
S.  22  provided  for  the  future  incorporation 
by  royal  charter  of  a  "  representative  body," 
of  bishops,  clergy,  and  laity  with  power  to 
hold  property,  real  and  personal  property. 
And  that  has  been  done. 

It  is  not  very  material,  but  the  Church 
Commissioners  were  dissolved,  and  all  the 
property  in  their  hands  transferred  to 
another  body,  established  for  secular  con- 
fiscation   purposes    by    the  same  author, 


DISESTABIJSHMENT 


299 


called  the  Irish  Land  Commission,  by  an 
Act  of  1881.  S.  23  of  the  18G9  Act 
enabled  the  clerical  holders  of  annuities 
assigned  as  above,  or  otlierwise  enjoyed, 
to  commute  them  with  the  consent  of  the 
representative  body,  and  the  Commissioners 
"  shall  pay  such  commuted  or  capitalised 
value  to  the  representative  body  charged 
with  tlie  payment  of  the  annuity.  By  s. 
25  disused  churches  not  suitable  for  resto- 
ration but  thought  worth  preserving  as 
national  monuments,  are  to  be  transferred 
to  the  Commissioners  for  Public  Works, 
with  some  confused  and  all  but  unintelligible 
provisions  for  payment  by  "  the  Ojmmis- 
sioners  "  to  "  the  said  Commissioners  " ; 
which  apparently  mean  that  the  Church 
Commissioners  are  to  pay  the  Public  Works 
Commissioners  what  the  paying  ones  deem 
necessary  for  maintaining  those  buildings 
as  national  monuments;  which  is  plainly 
unjust ;  for  in  no  sense  was  the  Church 
bound  to  maintain  them  for  the  edification 
of  admirers  of  ruins.  Churches  in  use  were 
to  be  transferred  to  the  repi-esentalive  body 
on  their  application:  but  if  they  did  not 
apply  before  a  specified  time,  the  founder  of 
the  church  or  his  heirs  might  apply  and  get 
it ;  and  failing  that  also,  they  may  dispose  of 
it  as  they  like ;  and  schoolhouses  connected 
therewith  also.  S.  26  provides  for  the  transfer 
of  burial-grounds  either  to  the  representative 
body  or  to  guardians  of  the  poor,  as  that 
body  may  desire,  subject  practically  to  the 
same  law  as  the  English  Burials  Act  of 
1880.  By  ss.  27, 28,  ecclesiastical  residences- 
of  all  kinds  were  first  taken,  or  in  plain. 
English,  stolen,  and  then  were  to  be  sold 
back  again  to  the  representative  body,  with 
the  gardens  and  curtilage,  for  ten  times  the 
annual  value  of  the  site  as  land,  and  the  Com- 
missioners may  also  sell  at  an  arbitration 
price  any  more  land  besides,  of  what  was 
usually  occupied  with  the  residence.  The 
effect  of  another  confused  clause,  29,  seems 
to  be  that  "  the  Commissioners  were  to  pay 
the  representative  body  half  a  million  in  lien 
of  (meaning  in  respect  of  or  for)  any  real  or 
personal  property  becoming  vested  in  them," 
which  had  arisen  from  private  subscription, 
and  without  prejudice  to  any  claim  upon  it. 
The  half  million  turned  out  to  be  more  than 
the  value  of  such  claims,  and  so  by  accident 
the  Church  got  back  a  little  more  of  the 
property  stolen  from  it  than  was  intended  : 
which  an  Irish  writer  in  the  Guardian  lately 
seemed  to  think  rather  liberal.  The  first 
time  he  is  robbed  of  his  watch  and  purse, 
and  given  back  a  shilling,  he  will  appreciate 
it  better. 

The  Commissioners  may  sell  to  the  land- 
lord (s.  32)  any  tithe  rent-charge  for  22^ 
times  its  amount  paid  do-wn,  or  for  an 
annual  payment  of  'OliS  on  such  capitalised 


309 


DISESTABLISI-DIEJJT 


value  for  52  jreavs,  deducting  rates :  which 
is  equivalent  to  paying  tlie  present  tithe  to 
tlie  Commissioners  for  52  years,  and  then 
ceasing;  but  titlies  to  laymen  will  continue 
— if  they  can  be  got  in,  or  any  payments  at 
all  by  that  time.  They  may  buy  up  any 
subsisting  leases  granted  by  ecclesiastical 
corporations.  Ss.  34-37  give  them  large 
powers  of  sale  not  necessary  to  set  out. 
Ss.  38-41  extinguished  the  Regium  Donum 
to  Protestant  Dissenters,  and  the  annual 
grant  to  Maynooth,  but  with  some  life 
compensations  and  fourteen  times  the  last- 
mentioned  grant  as  capital.  In  other  words, 
we  are  taxed  to  that  extent  for  those  bodies, 
while  the  money  of  the  Church  was  mostly 
taken  away,  and  reserved  by  s.  68  for 
future  disposal  of  Parliament,  which  has  not 
yet  taken  place.  That  section  says  it  is  to 
be  "appropriated  mainly  to  the  relief  of 
unavoidable  calamity  and  sufl'ering,  yet  not 
so  as  to  cancel  or  impair  the  obligations 
now  attached  to  property  under  the  Acts  for 
the  relief  of  the  poor  "  ;  but  such  directions 
to  future  Parliaments  are  unavailing,  every 
Parliament  being  omnipotent  while  the 
money  exists  unspent.  A  saving  clause 
(70)  exempts  privately-endowed  and  pro- 
prietary chapels  and  their  property.  It  is 
not  yet  kno'\vn  what  wUl,  or  is  likely  to  be, 
the  final  "  surplus  "  for  the  "  relief  of  un- 
avoidable calamity,"  but  it  is  certain  to  be 
much  less  than  was  predicted  when  the  Act 
passed.  Meanwhile  the  dilficulty  of  pro- 
viding clergymen  of  course  increases  as  the 
amiuitants  die  off,  but  the  results  are  too 
■complicated  to  attempt  to  give  accurately 
here.  The  declaration  of  the  last  Primate 
of  Ireland  is  not  likely  to  be  controverted 
now  after  fifteen  years'  experience :  "  The 
•disestablishment  of  the  Church  has  been 
only  an  evil  with  no  compensating  benefit 
whatever."  Certainly  the  progress  of  Ireland 
towards  ruin  and  barbarism  has  been  rapid 
■ever  since,  as  it  was  in  the  French  Bevolu- 
tiou  after  the  robbeiy  of  the  Church.  At 
the  Reformation  it  was  the  monasteries  that 
were  robbed,  which  had  become  utterly 
corrupt :  not  the  working  clergy  and  bishops 
and  cathedrals ;  on  the  contrary,  some  were 
founded  then. 

The  charter  was  granted  on  15  Oct., 
1870,  incorporating  as  "  The  Representa- 
tive Church  Body"  all  the  bishops  and 
48  other  persons,  viz. :  one  clerical  and 
two  lay  representatives  elected  for  every 
■diocese  under  one  bishop  (not  the  old 
.nominal  dioceses),  and  also  as  many  co-opted 
members  as  there  are  dioceses,  to  be  elected 
by  the  bishops  and  the  elected  members ; 
4)ut  with  power  for  the  general  synod  here- 
after to  alter  the  members.  One  third  of 
.the  elected  and  of  the  co-opted  are  to  retire 
annually,  hut  to  be  capable  of  re-election  by 


DISESTABLISHMENT 

the  synod  of  each  diocese,  lay  and  clerical 
members  voting  severally  for  their  own 
representatives.  That  is  substantially  the 
whole  of  the  charter,  the  powers  of  the 
representative  body  having  been  already 
defined  by  the  Act.  The  synod  has  from 
time  to  time  passed  sundry  ordinances  or 
"  statutes  "of  their  own  besides ;  and  finally 
(for  the  jiresent),  an  elaborate  constitution 
of  "  the  Church  of  Ireland  "  was  settled  in 
1879.  It  is  much  too  long  to  give  here, 
beyond  a  few  principal  articles.  (AH  these 
documents  have  been  published  from  time 
to  time  in  the  journals  of  the  general  con- 
vention, and  this  constitution  in  a  special 
volume  by  W.  G.  Brooke,  M.A.,  Chief 
Clerk  to  the  Lord  Chancellor  of  Ireland.) 
The  Church  receives  thereby  the  Thirty-nine 
Articles  and  the  Prayer  Book  of  1662,  and 
will  use  the  same  subject  to  such  alterations 
as  may  be  made  from  time  to  time  by 
authority  of  the  Church.  The  general 
synod  is  to  consist  of  three  orders,  the 
bishops,  the  clergy,  and  the  laity ;  and  of 
two  Houses,  Bishops  and  Representatives  ; 
of  whom  latter  are  to  be  208  clergy  and  416 
laymen,  the  numbers  for  each  of  the  twelve 
dioceses  being  defined,  from  ten  up  to 
twenty-four.  The  laymen  must  be  com- 
municants. Clergymen  having  property  in 
the  diocese,  but  without  cures,  are  reckoned 
as  laymen.  The  representatives  all  vote 
together,  unless  seventy  members  demand  a 
vote  by  orders,  and  then  no  vote  is  carried 
unless  by  a  majority  of  both  orders.  St. 
Patrick's  Cathedral  is  to  become  "  a  national 
cathedral,  havmg  a  common  relation  to  all 
the  dioceses  and  bishops,"  leaving  the 
smaller  one  of  Christ  Church  to  the  diocese 
of  Dublin  as  before.  Bishops  are  elected 
by  each  diocesan  synod  if  any  candidate  has 
finally  two  thirds  of  the  votes  of  each  order. 
If  not,  two  names  are  sent  up  to  the  Bench 
of  Bishops  and  they  select  one.  Incrun- 
bents  are  elected  by  a  Committee  of  Patron- 
age of  the  diocese  together  with  a  Board  of 
(three)  Nominators  apiwinted  by  the  vestry- 
men of  the  parish  vacant.  There  is  a  long 
chapter  of  thirty-eight  canons  (as  they  may 
be  called)  about  ecclesiastical  tribunals  and 
offences — a  sort  of  Clergy  Discipline  Act  by 
agreement,  which  the  Disestablishing  Act 
appears  to  authorise.  Then  comes  a  chapter 
of  fifty-four  constitutions  and  canons  mostly 
on  divine  service.  It  may  be  interesting  to 
notice  that  the  only  "  vestments"  allowed  are 
"  a  surplice  with  the  customary  scarf  of  plain 
black  silk,  and  the  hood  of  an  University 
degree,"  not  recognising  the  fancy  and 
illegal  hoods  of  theological  colleges  or  other 
places.  But  a  black  gown  inat/  be  used  in 
preaching.  And  the  minister  is  to  stand  at 
the  north  side  of  the  table  (or  what  would 
bo  north  if  the  church  stood  east  and  west) 


DISESTABLISHMENT 

at  the  consecration  prayer  in  the  Communion 
service.  And  no  one  shall  make  the  sign  of 
the  cross  or  bow  to  the  Lord's  table,  nor 
shall  any  bell  be  rung  during  service  :  nor 
incense  used,  nor  water  in  the  wine,  nor  lights 
in  the  church  except  when  needed,  nor 
crosses  on  or  near  the  Communion  table, 
which  is  to  be  a  moveable  wooden  one,  nor 
banners  or  processions  as  a  rite  or  ceremony 
except  when  prescribed  by  authority.  In 
short,  the  legal  decisions  of  the  Privy 
Council  have  been  followed  as  to  all  these 
things,  and  in  others  the  subsisting  canons 
of  1603  have  been  generally  adopted.  There 
is  an  important  one  added,  that  the  ordinary 
and  an  ecclesiastical  court  may  decide 
whether  a  person  is  to  be  excluded  from 
Communion,  all  over  Ireland,  unless  he 
satisfies  a  clergyman  of  his  repentance. 

II.  England.    So  much  has  been  written 
of  late  on  the  subject  of  what  is  called  Dis- 
estabhshment  in    England,   which   always 
means   disendowment,  which  again  means 
robbery  of  land  and  funds  now  held  on 
trusts  as  definite  as  any  Dissenting  chapel 
or  college,  that  it  is  hardly  worth  while  to 
enter  upon  it  here.     We  may  refer  instead 
to  the  various  little  books  of  the  Eev.  T. 
Moore  (S.P.C.K.),  and  to  the  late  Professor 
Brewer's  historical  work  on  the  Endowments 
of  the  Church  of  England,  second  edition, 
with  additions  by   Mr.   Dibdin   in    1885. 
There  has  been  a  little  subordinate  discus- 
sion in  the  newspapers  about  the  legal  effect 
of  disestablishment  without  robbery,   but 
that  is  so  entirely  unpractical  that  it  need 
not  be  considered  here.     Perhaps  the  most 
audacious  fonns  in  which  disestablishment 
has  been  proposed  are  those  of  some  eminent 
Dissenting  preachers,  with  a  denial  that  it 
is  disendowment,  viz. :  (1)  the  proposal  that 
they  should  have  the  same  rights  in  our 
churches  as  the  clergy  have.      They  have 
never  been  able  to  explain  what  more  right 
they  could  claim  in  the  churches  than  Jews, 
Turks  (Mahometans),  Infidels,  and  Atheists. 
The  other  jjroiwsal  (2)  to  abolish  all  articles 
and  standards  of  faith,  and  to  let  what  are 
absurdly  there  called   "  congregations  "  to 
choose  their  own  preachers^  is  practically 
worse;   for  that  is  not  disestablishing   the 
Church  of  England,  but  destroying  it,  since 
they  have  not  ventured  to  deny  what  was  put 
to  them,  that  a  church  (for  these  purposes) 
ipso  facto  means,  and  is,  and  must  be,  a  body 
with  some  standards  of  faith,  doctrine,  and 
rites    and    ceremonies.      Every    dissenting 
Church  (as  they  now  call  them)  is  so,  and 
its  standards  are  enforced  by  the  temporal 
courts  whenever  they  are  called  uix)n,  against 
any  ministers  who  transgress  them,  quite  as 
vigorously,  and  a  vast  deal  more  quickly, 
than  they  are  by  our  ecclesiastical  courts. 
And  as  the  clergy  themselves  never  scruple 


DISPENSATION 


301 


to  resort  to  the  tompoi-al  courts  when  they 
can  against  the  ecclesiastical,  and  once 
selected  for  that  purpose  a  Jewish  Master 
of  the  Rolls  (who  died  before  the  suit 
came  on),  many  people  think  it  would 
be  better  to  disestablish  the  ecclesiastical 
courts  altogether.  And  it  is  a  very  open 
question  what  good  the  Church  derives  from 
twenty-six  bishops  being  in  Parliament.  A 
great  law-lord  asked  what  else  disestablish- 
ment (without  robbery)  would  mean,  and 
the  only  answer  of  importance  was  that  the 
Sovereign  may  not  he  a  Papist,  or  marry 
one,  and  has  to  be  crowned  by  the  Primate 
of  all  England ;  all  which  could  easily  be 
provided  for  still.  But  the  question  is 
entirely  unpractical,  and  disestablishment 
alone  means  nothing  without  either  robbery 
or  destruction,  such  as  Mr.  Hopps  and  Dr. 
Parker  and  other  Dissenters  prefer.  The  only 
other  remark  that  we  need  make,  is,  that  not 
a  single  tithe-payer  is  aggrieved  by  tithes — 
and  certainly  no  more  by  those  paid  to  the 
clergy  than  to  the  laity.  For  he  or  his 
ancestors  either  bought  his  estate  for  so 
much  less  by  the  value  of  the  tithes,  or  he 
is  the  heir-at-law  of  the  man  who  originally 
gave  the  tithes  of  his  estate  to  some  church, 
which  is  just  as  good  as  if  he  had  given  a 
slice  of  the  estate  itself.  But  again,  neither 
disestablishers  nor  disendowers  mean  to 
present  the  tithes  to  the  landowners  who 
pay  them.    [G.]     (See  EstaUisliment.) 

DISPENSATION.  I.  The  providential 
dealing  of  God  with  His  creatures.  We 
thus  speak  of  the  Jewish  dispensation  and 
the  Christian  dispensation.  (See  Covenant 
of  liedemption.) 

II.  In  ecclesiastical  law,  by  dispensation 
is  meant  the  power  vested  in  archbishops  of 
dispensing,  on  particular  emergencies,  with 
certain  minor  regulations  of  the  Church, 
more  especially  in  her  character  as  an 
establi-^hment.  This  power  had  been 
usui-jjed  in  England  by  the  pope,  and  was 
held  by  liim  notwithstanding  the  statute  of 
provisions,  and  other  statutes  against  the 
papal  encroachments,  for  the  granting  dis- 
pensations was  one  great  branch  of  revenue 
of  the  See  of  Pome.  But  the  statute  21 
Hen.  VIII.  0.  21,  enacted  that  all  licences, 
dispensations,  &c.,  shall  be  in  the  power  of 
the  Archbishop  of  Canterbury ;  though  they 
shall  not  be  granted,  in  "cases  unwont," 
until  the  king  or  his  council  be  advertised 
thereof,  and  determine  that  the  same  shall 
pass.  The  Act  was  not  to  be  prejudicial 
"  to  the  Archbishop  of  York,  or  to  any 
bishop  of  this  realm,  but  that  they  may 
lawfully  dispense  in  all  cases  in  which  they 
were  wont  to  dispense  by  the  common  law, 
or  custom  of  the  realm  before  the  Ace." 

III.  Dispensation  or  special  licence  of 
marriage  is  reserved  to  the  Archbishop  of 


S02 


DISSENTEES 


Canterburv  by  the  Marriage  Act,  26  Geo.  II. 
c.  33 ;  and  4  Geo.  IV.  c.  76.  And  he  still 
grants  dispensations  for  holding  two  benefices 
iu  the  few  cases  where  they  are  allowed  by 
the  PluraUty  Acts. 

IV.  Among  customable  dispensations,  is 
the  right  of  conferring  degi'ces  of  all  kinds, 
which  is  vested  in  the  Archbishop  of  Canter- 
bury. But  though  the  "  Lambeth  degree," 
as  it  is  called,  allows  the  persons  nominated 
by  the  archbishop  to  wear  the  hood  of  one 
of  the  universities,  it  does  not  give  to  hun 
the  privileges  to  ■which  the  graduates  of  the 
universities  are  entitled.  He  has  no  vote ; 
the  degree  is  merely  nominal. 

DISSENTERS  are  simply  those  who 
dissent  from  the  doctrine  or  the  ritual  or 
government  of  the  Church  of  England.  Of 
late  they  have  taken  to  call  themselves 
"  Nonconformists"  ;  but  as  that  designation 
has  no  advantage  except  length  over  their 
old  legal  title,  we  prefer  to  keep  the  old 
one.  As  they  are  now  under  no  disabilities 
whatever,  it  is  unnecessary  to  record  the 
various  enactments  relating  to  them  since 
the  Eevolution  and  before  it.  They  and 
their  ministers  have  indeed  some  privileges 
beyond  churchmen  and  clergymen,  but  in 
matters  too  trifling  to  be  noticed  here,  except 
perhaps  that  they  are  not  disabled  from 
sitting  in  Parliament  or  municipal  corpora- 
tions as  the  clergy  are,  nor  from  pursuing 
any  other  calling  besides  that  of  preaching, 
as  the  clergy  are,  with  a  very  few  exceptions. 
And  the  modern  meaning  ot  toleration  seems 
to  be  that  they  are  entitled  to  share  in  en- 
dowments notoriously  founded  for  church- 
men, but  that  all  their  endowments  are 
sacred.  In  one  other  way  any  sect  may  be 
called  free,  viz. :  while  it  is  in  the  act  of 
forming  itself;  for  undoubtedly  any  number 
of  persons  may  form  a  new  sect  professing 
any  doctrines  and  establishing  any  ritual  that 
they  please,  and  building  what  the  Dissenters 
always  used  to  call  "  meeting  houses,"  but 
now  "chapels,"  for  themselves.  But  the 
snoment  they  have  settled  their  doctrine 
and  ritual  by  any  document  or  trust  deed  of 
ttbeir  chapels,  they  are  quite  as  much  bound 
Iby  it  as  churchmen  and  clergymen  ;  and 
.experience  has  sho\vn  that  their  ministers 
:are  dealt  with  by  the  civil  courts  much 
miore  summarily  than  clergymen  by  the 
■ecclesiastical.  The  great  and  decisive  legal 
decisions  to  that  effect  are  on  Lady  Hewley's 
charity,  A.  C  v.  Shore,  Sim  and  SJwre  v. 
Wilson,  9  CI.  &  Fin.,  where  a  number  of 
Unitarian  ministers  and  congregations  who 
had  got  possession  of  chapels  under  her 
rtrust  were  declared  intruders :  so  many, 
that  Parliament  passed  the  Act  7  &  6  Vict. 
,c.  45  at  the  suggestion  of  Lord  Lyndhurst, 
-who  had  himself  decided  Lady  Hewley's 
.ease ;  by  which  25  years'  usage  was  allowed 


DISSENTERS 

to  prevail  as  to  chapels  and  funds  of  which 
there  is  no  express  trust  by  wiU  and  deed 
prescribing  particular  doctrines.  Secondly, 
what  is  called  the  Huddersfield  case  of 
Jones  V.  Stannard,  where  the  Court  of 
Chancery  decided  that  a  preacher  not  only 
may  but  must  be  ejected  if  complained  of 
for  preaching  doctrines  contrary  to  the  trust 
of  the  chapel  or  the  bodj''  to  which  he 
professed  to  belong.  It  has  even  been 
carried  so  far  that  a  minister  of  what  is 
called  the  Scotch  Free  Church,  even  in 
England,  is  not  free  to  j)reach  anything 
contrary  to  their  principles,  although  they 
separated  from  the  Scotch  Church  solely  on 
the  question  of  patronage,  which  can  have 
no  meaning  in  England,  where  they  are 
both  equally  Dissenters,  and  the  question  of 
patrons'  rights  cannot  arise. 

Another  point  in  which  dissenting  minis- 
ters are  much  less  free  than  those  of  the 
Church,  is  that  the  majority  of  the  congrega- 
tion or  its  elders  or  "  deacons,"  who  are  a 
kind  of  select  vestry,  can  dismiss  the  minis- 
ter absolutely  at  their  pleasure.  This  also 
was  decided  by  the  Court  of  Chancery  in 
Cooper  V.  Gordon  (8  Eq.)  in  1869.  And  an- 
other is,  that  they  depend  absolutely  on  the 
congregation  for  their  salary.  In  those  two 
respects  the  congregations  indeed  are  free 
enough,  but  the  minister  is  in  complete 
bondage,  even  though  he  conforms  ever  so 
much  to  the  trust  deed,  or  is  ever  so  "  or- 
thodox" according  to  their  standard.  If  he 
violates  that,  one  man  can  eject  him  through 
the  civil  court ;  and  if  he  does  not,  a  majority 
of  the  congregation  can  both  starve  and 
eject  him  without  the  court.  The  powers  of 
the  trustees  and  the  congregations  may  vary 
according  to  the  trust  deeds ;  but  this  account 
of  them  is  generally  correct.  These  are  the 
real  liberties  of  the  ministers  of  a  non- 
established  Church.  That  of  Roman  priests 
is  notoriously  the  will  of  their  superiors. 
In  that  Church  obedience  to  bishops  does 
not  mean  obedience  where  the  inferior 
thinks  the  superior  right  and  therefore  his 
commands  lawful,  but  absolute  and  inevi- 
table submission.  A  sexton  in  the  Church 
of  England  has  far  more  security  of  tenure 
than  a  minister  of  any  other  Church  or 
sect,  unless  he  happens  to  own  his  chapel 
and  to  be  rich  enough  to  maintain  himself 
and  it,  or  clever  enough  to  fill  his  pews 
with  paying  hearers.  The  impossibility  of 
altering  dissenting  doctrines  of  ritual  is  so 
complete  that  it  has  occasionally  been  done 
by  special  Acts  at  (we  suppose)  the  unani- 
mous request  of  the  body.  Two  of  such 
Acts  were  passed  in  1882  for  the  Irish 
Presbyterians  and  the  Piimitive  Methodists. 

It  is  true  that  any  sect  may  by  its  original 
constitution  provide  an  internal  judicature 
to  decide  on  the  orthodoxy  of  its  ministers, 


DIVINE 

;and  some  have  done  so  ;  aud  the  decision  of 
that  tribunal  would  be  accepted  by  the  civil 
•court  on  the  same  ground  of  preliminary 
■contract.  But  we  should  think  that  any 
minister  charged  with  heterodoxy  would 
■very  much  prefer  being  tried  by  an  ex- 
traneous court,  which  the  experience  of  our 
supreme  ecclesiastical  tribunal,  the  Judicial 
•Committee  of  the  Privy  Council,  has  proved 
to  be  far  more  tolerant  than  any  dominant 
majority  of  ecclesiastics  or  "  elders "  or 
■"  deacons  "  ever  were.  So  that  distinction 
Is  by  no  means  in  the  direction  of  "  liberty 
of  preaching,"  in  the  sects  which  have  such 
a  tribunal  of  their  own,  which  really  delivers 
■over  to  the  secular  arm,  or  the  coercive 
jurisdiction  of  the  court,  its  heretical  minis- 
ters to  be  imprisoned  if  they  resist  the 
deprivation  by  what  we  may  call  the  eccle- 
siastical authority. 

When  the  first  edition  of  this  Dictionary 
was  published  it  was  stated  that  there  were 
thirty-four  dissenting  communities  or  sects  ; 
4here  are  now  more  than  170.  (See  for  a  list 
Whitaker's  Almanack,  p.  204.)     [C] 

DIVINE.  Something  relating  to  God; 
a  minister  of  the  gospel ;  a  priest ;  a  theo- 
losian.     (See  Clergy.) 

DIVINITY.  The  science  of  Divine 
things ;  theology ;  a  title  of  the  Godhead. 
(See  Theology.)  In  strictness,  meaning  that 
•department  of  sacred  knowledge  which  has 
more  peculiar  reference  to  the  attributes 
and  essence  of  God. 

DIVINE  SERVICE.  (See  Communion, 
Holy ;  Hours  of  Prayer  ;  Eucharist.) 

DIVORCE.  Until  the  Act  of  1857,  20 
&  2 1  Vict.  c.  85,  no  court  in  this  kingdom 
Jiad  power  to  decree  a  divorce  a  vinculo 
■matrimonii  of  persons  whose  marriage  had 
not  been  voidable  for  some  antecedent  cause, 
■and  for  no  subsequent  misconduct.  A 
valid  marriage  could  only  be  dissolved  by  a 
special  or  "private"  Act  of  Parliament, 
which,  by  the  rules  of  Parliament,  had 
to  be  preceded  by  an  action  for  crim. 
con.  and  a  decree  of  the  ecclesiastical 
court  for  a  divorce  a  mensd  et  toro.  Such 
biUs  always  began  in  the  House  of  Lords, 
and,  by  standing  order,  left  it  with  a  clause 
prohibiting  the  offending  ])arty  from  mar- 
rying the  co-adulterer;  which  clause  was 
always  struck  out  in  the  House  of  Com- 
mons, and  the  Lords  always  accepted  the 
amendment.  It  followed  that  none  but  rich 
jieople  could  obtain  a  divorce.  Whether 
divorces  and  re-marriages  are  ■wrong  or 
right,  that  mode  of  dealing  with  them 
was  indefensible,  and  accordingly  the  above 
Act  was  passed  for  establishing  a  new 
divorce  court  with  power  to  try  the  whole 
case  against  both  the  adulterers,  and  to 
give  damages  as  under  the  former  actions, 
and  to  decree    either  divorce    or   iudicial 


DIVOUCE 


303 


separation,  a  new  term  substituted  for  the 
old  divorce  a  Tnensd,  &c.  ;  and  all  eccle- 
siastical "suits  for  nullity  of  marriage" 
were  abolished,  and  of  course  divorce  Acts 
ceased.  Tlie  Court  of  Probate  and  Divorce 
established  by  that  Act  and  one  of  1859 
was  made  a  Division  of  the  High  Court  of 
Justice  in  1873 ;  and  sundry  amending  Acts 
have  since  been  passed,  as  usual  in  modern 
legislation,  of  which  it  is  unnecessary  to 
give  an  account  here.  The  court  has  large 
powers  as  to  alimony  and  the  custody  of 
infant  children. 

By  sect.  16  of  the  first  Act  a  wife  or 
husband  may  obtain  judicial  separation  for 
adulterj%  or  cruelty,  or  desertion  for  two 
years ;  and  by  sect.  21  a,  wife  deserted  by 
her  husband  may  at  any  time  get  pro- 
tection for  her  property  by  an  order  of 
justices,  and  by  a  later  Act  of  1841,  a 
judicial  separation  on  his  being  convicted 
of  an  aggravated  assault  on  her.  By 
sect.  27  a  husband  may  obtain  a  divorce 
from  the  court  for  his  wife's  adultery  alone ; 
and  she  may  for  incestuous  adultery  by 
him,  or  adultery  with  cruelty  or  bigamy, 
or  with  desertion  for  two  years  without 
good  excuse.  The  party  complaining  must 
always  be  free  from  adultery,  and  there 
must  be  no  collusion ;  and  the  intervention 
of  the  Queen's  proctor  to  prove  collusion 
was  allowed  by  an  Act  of  1858.  But  that 
is  evidently  very  difficult  to  prove ;  and 
even  witliout  collusion,  as  divorcees  may 
many  their  adulterer,  or  co-respondent,  as 
the  Acts  call  it,  there  is  practically  no 
check  on  a  woman  transferring  herself  to  a 
new  husband  by  committing  adultery  with 
him  first.  A  man  must  also  commit  cruelty 
for  his  wife  to  get  a  divorce.  And,  it  seems 
impossible  to  prevent  tliat  result,  so  long  as 
the  co-adulterers  are  allowed  to  marry  each 
oth'ir.  That  was  a  comparatively  small 
evil  when  divorces  were  as  rare  as  they 
used  to  be  on  account  of  their  cost ;  but  it 
is  very  different  now.  Clergymen  are  no 
longer  bound  to  marry  any  one  who  has 
been  divorced  for  adultery,  but  incumbents 
cannot  prevent  their  being  married  in  their 
church  by  any  other  clergyman  who  is 
willing  to  do  it,  if  they  are  otherwise  en- 
titled to  be  married  there.     [G.] 

Since  the  Acts  which  faciUtate  divorce 
and  legalise  the  marriage  of  divorced  persons 
have  been  passed,  the  number  of  divorces 
has  annually  increased.  This  natural  but 
deplorable  consequence  of  the  relaxation 
of  the  marriage  tie  by  human  law  only 
strengthens  the  conviction  held  by  sound 
Churchmen,  that  by  the  divine  law  mar- 
riage is  indissoluble. 

I.  This  conviction  is  based  primarily 
upon  the  direct  command  of  our  blessed 
Lord  :   "  What   God  hath  joined  together 


304 


DOCET^ 


let  no  man  ]iut  asunder."  This  He 
proclaimed  as  an  absolute  rule  in  contrast 
with  the  permission  to  obtain  divorce 
conceded  under  the  Mosaic  law  (St. 
Matt.  xix.  3-8).  The  seeming  excep- 
tion to  this  absolute  rule  contained  in 
the  words  (v.  Si)  "except  it  be  for  forni- 
cation "  ("  it  fifi  4m.  TTopveia")  in  reality  aug- 
ments its  binding  force.  The  word  wopvila 
always  signifies  incontinence  in  an  unmar- 
ried person  as  distinguished  from  /loixela, 
or  adulterj',  incontinence  in  a  married  per- 
son (comp.  St.  Mark  vii.  21 ;  St.  John 
viii.  3;  Gal.  v.  19 ;  Eph.  v.  3 ;  Col.  iii.  5; 
Heb.  xiii.  4);  and  our  Lord  is  here  re- 
feriingto  and  sanctioning  the  Jewish  law 
(see  Deut.  xxii.  20,  21),  that  an  unacknow- 
ledged act  of  fornication  on  the  part  of  the 
woman  previous  to  marriage  vitiated  the 
contract.  It  is  essential  to  the  validity  of 
a  contract  that  both  parties  should  assent 
to  it,  and  it  is  assumed  that  the  man  in 
such  a  case,  having  been  deceived,  was 
not  a  consenting  party.  The  law  then  as 
laid  down  by  our  Lord  Himself  is  that  the 
marriage  tie  is  indissoluble  where  the  mar- 
riage contract  is  valid. 

II.  The  ajx)stolical  arguments  and  pre- 
cepts respecting  marriage  clearly  proceed 
upon  the  view  that  the  bond  is  indissoluble 
(see  Eomans  vii.  1-3 ;  1  Cor.  vii.  16,  17  ; 
Eph.  V.  23,  25,  and  especially  the  latter). 
— See  on  this  point  the  Discourse  by  Bp. 
Andrewes  against  Marriage  after  Divorce; 
DolUnger's  First  Age  of  the  Church,  p.  366 ; 
and  a  pamphlet  on  Divorce  by  J.  Keble, 
Oxford,  1857. 

HI.  The  whole  structure  and  tone  of 
our  marriage  service  implies  the  same ;  the 
.solemn  warning  addressed  to  the  persons 
who  come  to  be  married  to  confess  any 
impediment  to  their  lawful  union ;  the 
question  put  to  them  both  whether  each 
will  "  forsake  all  other ''  and  "  keep  only  " 
to  the  husband  or  the  wife  "  as  long  as  they 
both  shall  live  "  ;  the  solemn  promise  made 
by  both  that  each  will  take  the  other  "to 
have  and  to  hold  from  this  day  forward  for 
better  for  worse,  till  death  us  do  part." 

It  seems  impossible  for  any  faithful 
priest  of  the  Church  of  England  to  sanction 
any  release  from  such  an  engagement,  or  to 
consent  to  marry  again  those  who  have 
violated  it.  Of  course  a  separation  "a 
mtnsd  et  toro"  may  be  sometimes  ne- 
cessary, but  that  is  quite  different  from  a 
divorce,  and  does  not  cancel  the  marriage 
bond.     [W.  E.  W.  S.] 

DOCETjE  (from  Sokuv,  to  seem).  Here- 
tics, who  taught  that  our  Lord  had  only  a 
seeming  body,  and  that  His  actions  and 
sufferings  were  not  in  reality,  but  in  appear- 
ance. The  foundation  of  the  heresy  has 
been  ascribed  to  Simon  Magus  (Hippolytus, 


DOMINICAL 

Itefut.  vi.  14).  Tliere  was  in  the  second 
century  a  sect  which  especially  bore  this 
name;  but  the  Docetic  error  was  common 
to  many  kinds  of  Gnostics.  (See  Gnostics.y 
DOCTOR  (From  docere,  to  teach).  I> 
Learned  persons  whose  teaching  was  of 
special  importance  in  the  Church.  Four 
bishops  in  the  early  Church  were  dis- 
tinctively called  "  doctors,"  SS.  Ambrose, 
Jerome,  Augustine,  and  Gregory. 

II.  In  the  early  Church  the  "doctor 
audientium,"  master  of  the  hearers,  was 
the  catechist  of  the  lowest  order  of  catechu- 
mens.— Bingham,  iii.  x. 

III.  One  who  has  the  highest  degree  in 
the  faculties  of  divinity,  law,  physic,  or 
music.     (See  Degree.") 

DOCTEINE.  A  system  of  teaching. 
By  Christian  doctrine  should  be  intended 
the  principles  or  ]X)sitions  of  the  Holy 
Catholic  and  Apostolic  Church. 

DOGMA  (fiayiia).  A  Greek  word, 
which  has  been  adopted  into  English 
without  any  change  of  form  or  (strictly 
speaking)  of  meaning.  It  is  derived  from 
the  verb  hoKilv  used  in  its  intransitive 
sense,  "  to  seem,"  and  so  "  to  seem  good." 
The  noun  h6yy.a  and  the  participles  to 
So^av  or  TO  dfdoyiifpov  all  alike  signify 
"  that  which  has  seemed  good,"  and  so 
"  that  which  has  been  resolved  or  decreed." 
They  are  equivalent  to  the  Latin  placitum 
hoxa  placet,  that  which  pleases — that  which 
has  received  the  approval  of  the  majority. 
Thus  Plato  defines  a  law  as  that  kolvov  hoyiia, 
that  common  decision,  or  decree  which  has 
been  arrived  at  after  Aoytcr/xor,  or  delibera- 
tion in  the  legislative  assembly. — Legg. 
6440.  So  in  the  Acts  of  the  Apostles  the 
resolutions  arrived  at  by  the  council  of 
Jerusalem  (ch.  xv.)  are  called  in  ch.  xvi.  4 
the  "dogmata"  or  "decrees."  Properly 
speaking,  therefore,  a  dogma  is  the  formal 
statement  of  some  truth  or  principle,  whether 
political,  philosophical,  or  religious,  by  a, 
representative  body  as  distinct  from  the 
opinion  of  an  individual.  Every  science 
has  its  dogmas,  which  are  the  results  of 
past,  and  the  starting  points  of  future 
investigation.     [H.] 

DOMINICAL  or  SUNDAY  LETTER. 
In  the  calendar,  the  first  seven  letters  of 
the  alphabet  are  applied  to  the  days  of  the 
week,  the  letter  A  being  given  to  the  1st  of 
January,  and  the  others  in  succession  to 
the  following  days.  If  the  year  consisted 
of  364  days,  making  an  exact  number  of 
weeks,  it  is  evident  that  no  change  would 
ever  take  place  in  these  letters  :  thus,  sup- 
posing the  1st  of  January  in  any  given 
year  to  be  Sunday,  all  the  Sundays  would 
be  represented  by  A,  not  only  in  that  year, 
but  in  all  succeeding.  But  as  there  are 
365  days  in  the  year,  the  first  letter  comes 


DOBIINICAN 

again  on  tlie  31st  of  December,  and  conse- 
quently the  Sunday  letter  for  the  foUownig 
year  will  be  G.  This  retrocession  of  the 
letters  will  continue  every  year,  so  as  to 
make  P  the  dominical  letter  of  the  third,  &o. 
If  every  year  were  common,  the  process 
would  continue  regularly,  and  a  cycle  of 
seven  years  would  suflice  to  restore  the 
same  letters  to  the  same  days  as  before. 
But  the  intercalation  of  a  day,  every  leap 
or  bissextile  or  fourth  year,  has  occasioned 
a  variation  in  this  respect.  Leap  year, 
containing  366  instead  of  365  days,  throws 
the  dominical  letter  of  the  following  year 
back  two  letters,  so  that  if  the  letter  at  the 
beginning  of  the  year  be  C,  the  letter  of  the 
next  year  will  be,  not  B,  but  A.  This  alter- 
ation is  not  effected  by  dropping  a  letter 
altogether,  but  by  chanjjing  the  dominical 
letter  at  the  end  of  Pebruarj',  where  the 
intercalation  of  a  day  takes  jslace. 

Consequently  all  the  leap  years  have  two 
Sunday  letters,  of  which  the  first  goes  to 
the  29th  of  February.  That  lias  no  letter 
given  to  it  in  the  calendar,  but  would  have 
that  of  the  22nd  repeated,  which  is  D,  the 
same  as  of  March  1  in  common  years. 
For  if  February  22  is  Sunday,  of  course 
February  29  is,  and  thus  March  1  is 
Monday,  which  has  D  attached  to  it  in  the 
calendar,  and  the  next  Sunday  will  be 
March  7,  of  which  the  letter  is  0 ;  and 
therefore  C  is  the  Sunday  letter  of  the  rest 
of  that  year,  and  its  two  letters  appear  as 
D  0  in  all  such  tables  as  above.  See 
Calendar,  in  Sir  E.  Beckett's  Astronomy 
(S.  P.  C.  K.),  and  his  tables  of  Easter  days 
and  Sunday  letters  in  Whitaker's  Ahnanach 
of  1884  and  1885  for  400  years.     [G.] 

DOMINICAN  MONKS.  The  religious 
Order  of  Dominic,  or  friars  preachers 
(^Fratres  priedicatores') ;  called  in  England 
Black  friars,  and  in  France  Jacobins,  or 
Jacobites,  because  the  first  domicile  granted 
to  them,  at  Paris,  was  sacred  to  St.  James 
(Eue  de  St.  Jacques). 

Dominic  de  Guzman  was  born  in  the 
year  1170,  at  Calahorra  or  Calamega,  a 
small  town  of  the  diocese  of  Osma,  in  Old 
Castile.  It  has,  however,  been  disputed 
that  St.  Dominic  was  of  the  noble  house  of 
Guzman.  He  was  early  sent  to  the  high 
school  at  Palentia,  in  the  kingdom  of  Leon, 
where  he  spent  four  years  in  the  study  of 
philosophy  and  divinity.  From  that  time 
he  devoted  himself  to  all  manner  of  re- 
ligious austerities,  and  he  employed  his 
time,  successfully,  in  the  conversion  of 
sinners  and  heretics.  In  1199  the  bishop 
of  Osma  made  him  a  presbyter,  and  a 
canon  of  his  cathedral.  He  soon  after 
became  sub-prior  of  the  chapter.  He  was 
now  very  devotional,  studious,  zealous  for 
the  faith,  and  a  mighty  preacher.     In  1206 


DOMINICAN 


305 


the  bishop  took  Dominic  with  him  into  the 
south  of  France,  where  they  met  the  legate 
of  Innocent  III.,  and  others  who  were 
labouring  to  convert  the  Albigenses.  The 
bishop  of  Osma  told  them  that  they  wore 
not  taking  the  right  course,  and  that  they 
ought  to  go  forth,  unadorned,  without 
purse  or  scrip,  like  the  Apostles.  He  and 
Dominic  set  them  an  example  which  was 
followed  with  good  success.  After  visiting 
Rome,  the  bishop  had  leave  from  the  pope  to 
preach  in  France  during  two  years ;  which 
he  did,  with  Dominic  and  others  assisting 
him.  When  the  bishop  returned  to  Spain, 
Dominic  remained  behind,  and  here  it  was 
that  Dominic  resolved  to  put  in  execution 
the  design  he  had  long  formed,  of  institu- 
ting a  religious  order,  whose  principal 
employment  should  be,  preaching  the 
gospel,  converting  heretics,  defending  the 
faith,  and  propagating  Christianity.  By 
degrees  he  collected  together  several  per- 
sons, inspired  with  the  same  zeal,  whose 
number  soon  increased  to  sixteen.  Pope 
Innocent  III.  confirmed  this  institution,  at 
the  request  of  Dominic,  who  went  to  Rome 
for  that  purpose,  and  attended  the  general 
Lateran  Council,  a.d.  1215.  They  then 
agreed  to  embrace  the  rule  of  St.  Augustine, 
to  which  they  added  statutes  and  constitu- 
tions which  had  formerly  been  observed 
either  by  the  Carthusians  or  the  Premon- 
stratenses.  The  principal  articles  enjoined 
perpetual  silence,  abstinence  from  flesh 
at  all  times,  wearing  of  woollen,  rigorous 
poverty,  and  several  other  austerities. 

The  first  monastery  of  this  order  was 
established  at  Toulouse,  by  the  bounty  of 
the  bishop  of  Toulouse,  and  Simon  earl  of 
Montfort.  From  thence  Dominic  sent  out 
some  of  the  community  to  several  districts, 
to  labour  in  preaching,  which  was  the  main 
design  of  his  institute.  In  the  year  1218 
he  founded  the  convent  of  Dominicans  at 
Paris,  in  the  Rue  St.  Jaques.  At  Metz,  in 
Germany,  he  founded  another  monastery  of 
his  order ;  and  another,  soon  after,  at 
Venice.  At  Rome,  he  obtained  of  Pope 
Honorius  III.  the  church  of  St.  Sabina, 
where  he  and  his  companions  took  the 
habit  which  they  pretended  the  Blessed 
Virgin  showed  to  the  holy  Eenaud  of 
Orleans,  being  a  white  garment  and 
scapular,  to  which  they  added  a  black 
mantle  and  hood  ending  in  a  point.  In 
1221,  the  order  had  sixty  monasteries, 
being  divided  into  eight  provinces,  those 
of  Spain,  Toulouse,  France,  Lombardy, 
Rome,  Provence,  Germany  and  England. 
St.  Dominic,  having  thus  settled  and  en- 
larged his  order,  died  at  Bologna.  August 
4th,  1221,  and  was  canonized  by  Pope 
Gregory  IX.,  July  13th,  1234. 

The  order  of  the  Dominicans  after  the 


.SOG 


DOMINICAN 


death  of  their  founder,  made  a  very  con- 
siderable progress  in  Europe  and  elsewhere. 
They  therefore  erected  four  new  provinces, 
namely,  those  of  Greece,  Poland,  Denmark, 
and  the  Holy  Land.  Afterwards  the  num- 
her  of  monasteries  increased  to  such  a  de- 
gree, that  the  order  was  divided  into  forty- 
five  provinces,  having  spread  itself  into  all 
parts  of  the  world.  It  has  produced  a  great 
number  of  martyrs,  confessors,  bishops,  and 
holy  virgins:  there  are  reckoned  of  this 
order  3  popes,  60  cardinals,  150  arch- 
bishops, 800  bishops,  besides  the  masters 
of  the  sacred  palace,  who  have  always  been 
Dominicans. 

There  are  nuns  of  this  order,  who  owe 
their  foundation  to  St.  Dominic  himself, 
■who,  whilst  he  was  labouring  on  the  con- 
version of  the  Albigenses,  was  so  much 
concerned  to  see  that  some  gentlemen  of 
Guienne,  not  having  wherewith  to  main- 
tain their  daughters,  either  sold  or  gave 
them  to  be  brought  up  by  heretics,  that, 
■with  the  assistance  of  the  archbishop  of 
Narbonne,  and  other  charitable  persons, 
he  laid  the  foundation  of  a  monastery  at 
Prouille,  where  those  poor  maids  might  be 
brought  up,  and  supplied  with  all  neces- 
saries for  their  subsistence.  The  habit 
of  these  "  religious "  was  a  white  robe,  a 
tawny  mantle,  and  a  black  veil.  Their 
founder  obliged  them  to  work  at  certain 
hours  of  the  day,  and  particularly  to  spin 
yarn  and  flax.  The  nuns  of  this  order 
have  above  130  houses  in  Italy,  45  in 
France,  50  in  Spain,  15  in  Portugal,  40  in 
Germany,  and  many  in  Poland,  Russia,  and 
other  countries.  They  never  eat  flesh, 
excepting  in  sickness ;  they  wear  no  linen, 
and  Me  on  straw  beds;  but  many  monas- 
teries have  mitigated  this  austerity. 

In  the  year  1221,  Dominic  sent  Gilbert 
du  Fresney,  with  twelve  brothers,  into 
England,  where  they  founded  their  first 
house  at  Oxford  the  same  year,  and  soon 
after  another  at  London.  In  the  year 
1276,  the  mayor  and  aldermen  of  the  city 
of  London  gave  them  two  streets  by  the 
river  Thames,  where  thej''  had  a  very  com- 
modious monastery;  whence  that  place  is 
still  called  Black  Friars.  They  had  mon- 
asteries likewise  at  Warwick,  Canterbury, 
Stamford,  Chelmsford,  Dunwich,  Ipswich, 
Norwich,  Thetford,  Exeter,  Brecknock, 
Langley,  Guildford,  and  other  places. 

The  Dominicans,  being  fortified  with  an 
authority  from  the  court  of  Rome  to  preach 
and  take  confessions,  made  great  encroach- 
Bients  upon  the  rights  of  English  bishops  and 
the  parochial  clergy,  insisting  upon  a  liberty 
of  preaching  wherever  they  thought  fit. 
And  many  persons  of  quality,  especially 
■women,  deserted  from  the  parochial  clergy, 
and  confessed  to  the  Dominicans,  insomuch 


DONATISTS 

that  the  character  of  the  local  clergy  was 
greatly  lowered  thereby.  The  Dominicans 
were  everywhere  the  advocates  of  the  pope, 
and  enemies  to  the  independence  of  the 
Church  of  England.  They  not  only  set  up 
altar  against  altar,  but  delighted  in  turn- 
ing the  parish  priest  into  ridicule.  This 
innovation  made  way  for  a  dissoluteness 
of  manners ;  for  the  people,  being  under  no 
necessity  of  confessing  to  their  parish  priest, 
broke  through  their  duty  with  less  reluc- 
tancy,  in  hopes  of  meeting  with  a  Domini- 
can confessor,  those  friars  being  generally 
itinerant  and  strangers  to  their  penitents. — 
Matthew  Paris,  845  ;  Broughton's  Biblio. ; 
Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  ii.  194;  Hook's 
Archbps.  ii.  53  seq. ;  Robertson's  C/i.  Hist. 
iii.  364;  Milman's  Lat.  Christianity,  iv. 
161.     [H.] 

DONATISTS.  Schismatics,  originally 
partisans  of  Donatus,  an  African  by  birth, 
and  bishop  of  Casx  Nigrm,  in  Numidia. 
Another  Donatus  succeeded  Majorinus  as 
bishop  of  Carthage,  and  on  account  of 
his  learning  and  virtues  was  honoured 
by  his  partisans  with  the  title  of  Great. 
From  which  the  party  took  its  name  is  im- 
material, but  the  first  was  the  cause  of  the 
schism.  A  secret  hatred  against  Cascilian, 
elected  bishop  of  Carthage,  notwithstanding 
the  opposition  of  Donatus,  excited  the  latter 
to  form  one  of  the  most  pernicious  schisms 
that  ever  disturbed  the  peace  of  the  Church. 
He  accused  Casciliaa  of  having  delivered 
up  the  sacred  books  to  the  Pagans,  and 
pretended  that  his  election  was  thereby 
void,  and  all  those  who  adhered  to  him 
heretics.  Under  this  false  pretext  of  zeal 
for  the  Church,  he  set  up  for  the  head  of 
a  party,  and  about  the  year  312,  taught 
that  baptism,  administered  by  heretics, 
was  nuU ;  that  the  Church  was  not  infal- 
lible ;  that  it  had  erred  in  his  time ;  and 
that  he  ■was  to  be  the  restorer  of  it  (Op- 
tatus,  i.  xxiv. :  Dupin's  Ed.  note).  But 
a  council,  held  at  Aries  in  314,  acquitted 
Cajcilian,  and  declared  his  election  valid. 

The  schismatics,  irritated  at  this  sen- 
tence, refused  to  acquiesce  in  the  decisions 
of  the  council ;  and  the  more  firmlj''  to  sup- 
port their  cause,  they  thought  it  better  to 
subscribe  to  the  opinions  of  Donatus,  and 
openly  to  declaim  against  the  Catholics : 
they  gave  out  that  the  Church  was  become 
prostituted ;  they  re-baptized  the  Catho- 
lics; they  trod  vmder  foot  the  Eucharist 
consecrated  by  priests  of  the  Catholic  com- 
munion ;  they  overthrew  their  altars,  burned 
their  churches,  and  ran  up  and  down  de- 
crying the  Church  (See  Circumcellians). 
They  had  chosen  into  the  place  of  Crecilian 
one  Majorinus ;  but  he  dying  soon  after, 
they  brought  in  one  Donatus,  different 
from  him  of  Casai  Nigrse. 


DONATrV^E 

This  new  head  of  the  cabal  used  so 
much  violence  against  the  Catholics,  that 
the  schismatics  took  their  name  from  liim. 
But  as  they  could  not  prove  that  they 
composed  a  true  Church,  they  sent  one  of 
their  bishops  to  Rome,  who  secretly  took 
upon  him  the  title  of  bishop  of  Eome. 
This  bishop  being  dead,  the  Donatists  ap- 
pointed him  a  successor.  They  attempted 
likewise  to  send  some  bishops  into  Spain, 
that  they  might  say  their  Church  began 
to  spread  itself  everywhere ;  but  it  was 
only  in  Africa  that  it  could  gain  any  con- 
siderable footing,  and  this  want  of  diffu- 
sion was  much  insisted  on  by  their  op- 
ponents as  an  argument  against  their  pre- 
tensions. 

After  many  vain  efforts  to  crush  this 
schism,  the  emperor  Honorius  assembled 
a  council  of  bishops  at  Carthage,  in  the 
year  410;  where  a  disputation  was  held 
between  seven  of  each  party.  At  this  con- 
ference 286  Catholic,  and  279  Donatist 
bishops  were  present.  Marcellinus,  the 
•emperor's  deputy,  who  presided  in  that 
assembly,  decided  in  favour  of  the  Catho- 
lics, and  ordered  them  to  take  possession  of 
aU  the  chm-chos,  which  the  Donatist  bishops 
had  seized  on  by  violence,  or  otherwise. 
.■St.  Augustine  brought  his  power  to  bear  on 
the  controversy.  He  proved  that  the 
"Church,  by  the  unavoidable  tolerance  of 
wicked  men,  had  not  forfeited  its  character 
of  sanctity,  truth  and  Catholicity.  This 
decree  exasperated  the  Donatists ;  but  the 
Catholic  bishops  used  so  much  wisdom  and 
prudence,  that  they  insensibly  brought  ovei- 
most  of  those  who  had  strayed  from  the 
ibosom  of  the  Church.  Gregory  the  Great 
«,fterwards  vigorously  opposed  the  Dona- 
tists, and  was  successful — at  least  no  men- 
ition  is  made  of  Donatists  after  his  time. 
— Broughton's  Bihlio. ;  Stubbs'  Soames" 
Mosheim,  i.  289,  292,  362,  427 ;  Dbllinger's 
<Ch.  Hist.  (Cox's  Trans.),  ii.  p.  101,  &c. 

DONA'LTVE.  A  donative  is  when  the 
Iking,  or  any  subject  by  his  licence,  founds 
la  church  or  chapel,  and  ordains  that  it 
shall  be  merely  in  the  gift  or  disposal  of 
ithe  patron,  and  vested  absolutely  iu  the 
<:lerk  by  the  patron's  deed  of  donation, 
without  presentation,  institution,  or  induc- 
tion. This  is  said  to  have  been  anciently 
ithe  only  way  of  conferring  ecclesiastical 
benefices  in  England ;  the  method  of  in- 
stitution by  the  bishop  not  being  estab- 
lished before  the  time  of  Archbishop 
Becket  in  the  reign  of  Henry  II.  And 
itherefore  Pope  Alexander  IIL  (Decretal,  1. 
3,  t.  7,  c.  3),  in  a  letter  to  Becket,  severely 
dnveio-hs  against  the  prava  consuetvdo,  as 
lie  calls  it,  of  investiture  conferred  by  the 
patron  only  :  this  however  shows  what  was 
(then  the  common  usage.     Others  contend. 


DOET 


307 


that  the  claim  of  the  bishops  to  institution 
is  as  old  as  the  first  planting  of  Christianity 
in  this  island ;  and,  in  proof  of  it,  they 
allege  a  letter  from  the  English  nobility  to 
the  pope  in  the  reign  of  Henry  lit.,  record- 
ed by  Matthew  Paris  (a.d.  1236),  which 
speaks  of  presentation  to  the  bishop  as  a 
thing  immemoriah  'i'he  truth  seems  to  be 
that,  where  a  benefice  was  to  be  conferred 
on  a  mere  layman,  he  was  first  presented  to 
the  bishop,  in  order  to  receive  ordination, 
who  was  at  liberty  to  examine  and  refuse 
him :  bul  where  the  clerk  was  already  in 
orders,  the  living  was  usually  vested  in  him 
by  the  sole  donation  of  the  patron;  until 
about  the  middle  of  the  twelfth  century, 
when  the  Pope  endeavoured  to  introduce  a 
kind  of  feudal  dominion  over  ecclesiastical 
benefices,  and,  in  consequence  of  that,  began 
to  claim  and  exercise  the  right  of  insti- 
tution imiversally  as  a  species  of  spiritual 
investiture. 

By  the  Act  14  &  15  Vict.  c.  97,  sec.  9, 
the  right  of  perpetual  nomination  of  an 
incumbent  may  be  acquired  by  the  person 
or  body,  their  heirs,  &c.,  who  shall  procure 
a  church  to  be  erected  and  endowed. 

DONNELLAN  LEOTUKES.  Mrs. 
Anne  Donnellan,  in  the  last  century,  be- 
queathed a  sum  of  £1243  to  the  college 
of  Dublin,  for  the  encouragement  of  reli- 
gion, learning,  and  good  manners;  the 
application  of  the  sum  being  intrusted  to 
the  provost  and  senior  fellows ;  who,  con- 
sequently, in  1794,  resolved,  that  a  lecturer 
should  be  annually  appointed  to  preach 
six  lectures  in  the  college  chapel;  the 
subject  of  the  lectures  for  each  year  being 
determined  by  them.  The  other  regulations 
are  analogous  to  those  of  the  Bampton 
Lectures  at  Oxford.  Many  distinguished 
works  have  been  the  fruits  of  this  Lec- 
ture :  among  them  may  be  mentioned  Dr. 
Graves'  Lectures  on  the  Pentateuch,  Arch- 
bishop Magee  on  Prophecy,  &c. 

DORMITORY,  DOETOR,  or  DOE- 
TURE.  The  sleeping  apartment  in  a  mon- 
astic institution. 

A  place  of  sepulture  is  also  so  called, 
with  reference,  like  the  word  cemetery, 
which  has  the  same  meaning,  to  the  re- 
surrection, at  which  time  the  bodies  of  the 
saints,  which  for  the  present  repose  iu  their 
graves,  shall  arise,  or  awake.  But  it  must 
be  borne  in  mind,  that  the  word  has  refer- 
ence to  the  sleep  of  the  body,  and  not  of 
the  soul,  which  latter  was  never  an  article 
of  the  Christian  faith. 

DORT  (See  ,  Ccdvinists).  The  Synod 
of  Dort  was  convened  (a.d.  1618-19)  to 
compose  the  troubles  occasioned  by  the  cele- 
brated Arminian  controversy  (See  Ar- 
minians).  The  English  commissioners 
were   Carleton,    bishop  of  Llandaff;    Hall, 

X  2 


308 


DOXOLOGY 


dean  of  Worcester;  Davenant,  Margaret 
Professor;  and  Ward,  Master  of  Sidney 
Coll.,  Cambridge.  Afterwards  Balcanqual, 
a,  Scotchman,  joined  them.  The  latter 
wrote,  "  We  are  like  to  make  the  synod  a 
thing  to  be  laughed  at  in  after  ages.  The 
President  and  his  provincials  would  have 
their  canons,  so  full  charged  with  cate- 
chetical speculations,  as  they  will  be  ready 
to  burst"  (Balcanqual  Letters  in  Hales' 
JSemains,  p.  141).  The  foreigners  were 
treated  with  little  respect  (pp.  73,  78). 
The  commissioners  were  sent  by  the  king, 
not  by  the  Church  of  England ;  they  appear 
to  have  acted  with  moderation. 

The  synod  adopted  the  Belgic  Confession, 
decided  in  favour  of  absolute  decrees,  and 
excommunicated  the  Ai-minians.  Its  canons 
were  published  under  the  title  of  "  Judicium 
Synodi  nationalis  reformatarum  ecclesiarum 
habiti  Dordrechti  anno  1618  et  1619,  de 
quinque  dootrinas  capitibus,  in  ecclesiis 
Belgicis,  controversis :  Promulgatum  VI. 
Mail  MDCXIX.  4to."  It  concludes  the 
Sylloge  Confessionum,  printed  at  the  Claren- 
don press. — Butler's  Confession  of  Faith; 
Collier,  vol.  vii. 

DOXOLOGY  (See  Gloria  Patri).  A 
hymn  used  in  the  Divine  seiTice  of  Chris- 
tians. The  ancient  doxology  was  only  a 
single  sentence,  without  a  response,  running 
in  these  words :  "  Glory  be  to  the  Father, 
and  to  the  Son,  and  to  the  Holy  Ghost, 
world  without  end.  Amen."  Part  of  the 
latter  clause,  "As  it  was  in  the  beginning, 
is  now,  and  ever  shall  be,"  was  inserted 
Fome  time  after  the  first  composition.  The 
fourth  Council  of  Toledo,  in  the  year  633, 
added  the  word  "  honour  "  to  it,  and  read  it, 
"  Glory  and  honour  be  to  the  Father,"  &c., 
because  the  prophet  David  says,  "Bring 
glory  and  honour  to  the  Lord."  It  is  not 
easy  to.  say  at  what  time  the  latter  clause 
was  ^inserted.  Some  ascribe  it  to  the 
Council  of  Nice,  and  suppose  it  was  added 
in  opposition  to  the  Arians.  But  the  first 
express  mention  made  of  it  is  in  the  second 
Council  of  VaisoD,  an.  529,  above  two 
centuries  later. 

There  .was  another  difierence  in  the  use 
of .  this  ancient  hymn ;  some  reading  it, 
"  Glory  be  to  the  Father,  and  to  the  Son, 
with  the  Holy  Ghost ; "  others,  "  Glory  be 
to  the  Father,  in  (or  by)  the  Son,  and  by 
the  Holy  Ghost."  This  difference  of  ex- 
pression occasioned  no  disputes  in  the 
Church,  till  the  rise  of  the  Arian  heresy : 
but,  when  the  followers  of  Arius  began  to 
make  use  of  the  latter,  and  made  it  a 
distinguishing  character  of  their  party,  it 
was  entirely  laid  aside  by  the  Catholics, 
and  the  use  of  it  was  enough  to  bring  any 
one  under  suspicion  of  heterodoxy. 

This  hymn  was  of  most  general  use,  and 


DULCINISTS 

was  a  doxology,  or  giving  of  praise  to  God,, 
at  the  close  of  every  solemn  ofSce.  The- 
Westera  Church  repeated  it  at  the  end  of 
every  psalm,  with  some  few  exceptions; 
and  omitted  it  on  the  three  days  before, 
Easter,  and  in  offices  of  the  dead ;  and  the 
Eastern  Church  used  it  only  at  the  end  of 
the  last  psalm.  Many  of  their  prayers  were 
also  concluded  with  it,  particularly  tlie 
solemn  thanksgiving,  or  consecration-prayer 
at  the  Eucharist.  It  was  also  the  ordinary 
conclusion  of  their  sermons. 

There  was  likewise  another  hymn,  of 
great  note  in  the  ancient  Church,  called  the 
great  doxology,  or  angelical  hymn,  begin- 
ning with  those  words,  which  the  angels 
sung  at  our  Saviour's  birth,  "  Glory  be  to 
God  on  high,"  frc.  This  was  chiefly  used 
in  the  Communion  Service.  It  was  also 
used  daily  in  men's  private  devotions.  In 
the  Apostolic  Constitutions  under  the  head- 
ing "  Daily  Prayers  "  this  doxology  is  given 
in  almost  the  same  form  as  at  present 
(vii.  xlvii.  sec.  v.).  In  the  Mozarabic  liturgy- 
it  is  appointed  to  be  sung  before  the  lessons 
on  Christmas  day.  St.  Chrysostom  often 
mentions  it,  and  observes  that  the  Ascetics, 
or  Christians  who  had  retired  from  the 
world,  met  together  daily  to  sing  this  hymn- 
It  is  also  quoted  and  directed  to  be  used  by- 
St.  Athanasius  in  his  treatise  on  Virginity 
{de  Virgin,  torn.  ii.  p.  122.  Bened.).  Who- 
first  composed  it,  adding  the  remaining  part 
to  the  words  sung  by  the  angels,  is  uncertain^ 
but  it  is  certainly  most  ancient  and  probably 
Apostolic. 

Both  these  doxologies  have  a  place  in  the 
liturgy  of  the  Church  of  England,  the- 
former  being  repeated  after  every  psalm,  the 
latter  used  in  the  Communion  Service. — 
Bingham,  bk.  xiv.  c.  ii. 

The  concluding  words  of  the  Lord's 
Prayer  in  St.  Matthew's  gospel  are  also 
called  the  Doxology  thereof.  In  several  of 
the  oldest  MSS.  it  is  omitted,  but  the  pre- 
ponderance of  evidence  is  greatly  in  favour 
of  it  (See  tlie  Speaker's  Commentary  and' 
Dean  Buryon  on  the  Revised  Version').  [H.J 

DRIPSTONE.  In  church  arohitectm-e, 
the  projecting  moulding  or  label  which, 
crowns  doors,  windows,  and  other  arches, 
outside  a  building,  and  sometimes  inside. 

DULCINISTS;  Heretics,  so  denominated 
from  one  Duloinus,  of  Novara  in  Lombardy,, 
who  lived  in  the  beginning  of  the  fourteenth 
century.  He  pretended  to  preach  the  reign, 
of  the  Holy  Ghost;  and  while  he  justly 
enough  rejected  the  pope's  authority,  he 
asserted  that  he  himself  was  the  head  of 
that  third  reign,  saying,  that  the  Father 
had  reigned  from  the  beginning  of  the 
world  to  the  coming  of  Christ;  and  the 
Son's  reign  began  then,  and  continued  until 
the  year  1300.     He  was  followed  by  a  great 


DULIA 

many  people  to  tlie  Alps,  where  he  with 
Margaretha,  the  sister  whom  he  had  chosen 
according  to  the  practice  of  his  sect,  was 
tortured  and  burnt  by  order  of  Clement  IV. 
in  1307.  The  sect  long  existed,  and  was 
not  extirpated  till  the  time  of  Boniface  IX., 
in  the  beginning  of  the  fifteenth  century. — 
Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  ii.  246. 

DULIA  (AouXeia).  The  worship  paid 
by  Romanists  to  saints  and  angels,  and  to 
images.  Not  denying  that  all  these  are 
made  by  them  objects  of  worship,  the  Pa- 
pists invent  a  distinction  of  many  kinds 
and  degrees  of  worship,  and  very  accurately 
assigQ  to  each  object  of  worsliip  its  proper 
amount  of  reverence.  The  lowest  degree  is 
the  dvlia,  which  is  given  to  saints  and 
angels.  Byperdulia  (yir(pSovXeia)  is  reserved 
for  the  Blessed  Virgin  alone :  and  Latria 
(Xarpeia)  is  given  to  the  Lord  himself,  and 
to  each  person  in  the  ever  blessed  and 
glorious  Trinity.  Images  of  either  of  these 
receive  a  relative  worship  of  the  same  order. 
An  image  of  a  saint  or  angel,  relative  Dulia : 
an  image  of  the  Blessed  Virgin,  relative 
hyperdulia:  an  image  of  either  person  of 
the  Blessed  Trinity,  relative  Latria  (See 
Idolatry,  Images,  Invocation  of  Saints, 
Latria). 

DUNKEES,  or  DIPPERS.  More  pro- 
perly Tunkers,  from  German  Tunhen,  to 
dip.  A  sect  of  Baptists,  originating  (1724) 
in  the  teaching  of  one  Conrad  Peysel  or 
Beissel,  a  Grerman,  in  Philadelphia,  one  of 
the  American  states.  They  are  distin- 
guished not  only  by  their  adherence  to  the 
right  of  baptism  with  trine  immersion, 
which,  like  other  Baptists,  they  of  course 
confine  to  adults,  but  also  by  their  rigid 
abstinence  from  flesh,  except  on  particular 
occasions;  by  their  living  in  monastic 
societies,  by  their  peculiar  garb,  like  that  of 
the  Dominican  friars,  and  by  their  scruples 
with  regard  to  resistance,  war,  slavery,  and 
litigation.  Their  great  settlement  is  at  a 
place  which  they  call  Euphrata,  in  allusion 
to  the  lament  of  the  Hebrews  in  their 
captivity,  which  they  used  to  pour  forth  to 
.their  harps  as  they  sat  on  the  banks  of  the 
Euphrates. 

DUNSTAN,  ST.,  Archbishop  of  Canter- 
bury, commemorated  in  the  English  Calen- 
dar on  May  19,  was  born  near  Glastonbury 
about  A.D.  924.  When  still  young  he  was 
made  abbot  of  Glastonbury,  and  reformed  the 
house  which  had  been  in  a  very  lax  state. 
He  was  the  chief  political  adviser  of  Eadred, 
in  whose  reign  the  West  Saxon  kingdom 
made  great  advances,  and  even  conquered 
Northumbria  from  the  Danes  A.n.  955. 
Under  Eadred's  successor,  Eadwig,  a  faction 
was  formed  against  Dunstan  which  succeeded 
in  forcing  him  from  the  country,  but  he  was 
recalled  by  Eadgar,  the  rival  and  afterwards 


EAGLE 


309 


the  successor  of  Eadwig,  and  made  bishop, 
first  of  Worcester  and  then  of  London, 
which  he  held  together  with  the  former  see. 
On  the  death  of  Eadwig  he  was  made 
archbishop  of  Canterbury  a.d.  960.  His 
sojourn  during  his  exile  at  a  great  Bene- 
dictine monastery  in  Flanders  had  inspired 
him  with  zeal  as  a  monastic  reformer,  and 
during  the  reign  of  Eadgar  he  was  earnest, 
though  not  fanatical,  in  promoting  the 
substitution  of  monks  (or  canons  in  many 
of  the  cathedrals.  His  political  views  also 
were  adopted,  and  the  "glorious  reign"  of 
Eadgar  "the  peaceful"  was  in  a  great 
measure  the  result  of  his  policy.  With  the 
accession  of  ./Ethelred  the  Unready  his 
political  influence  declined,  and  the  re- 
mainder of  his  life  till  his  death,  in  988,  was 
devoted  to  the  administration  of  his  diocese 
and  province,  and  the  pursuit  of  literature, 
music,  and  the  finer  handicrafts. — Memorials 
of  Dunstan,  edited  by  Dr.  Stubbs  (Master 
of  the  Rolls  Series). 

DUPLEX  QUERELA  is  the  name  of  a 
suit  in  the  Provincial  Court  by  a  presentee 
to  a  benefice  against  a  bishop  who  refused 
to  institute  him ;  and  is  probably  so  called 
because  the  patron  may  sue  the  bishop  at 
the  same  time  in  the  civil  court  by  a  qimre 
impedit  (q.v).  It  is  very  literally  translated 
in  the  95th  Canon,  which  says  that  no 
double  qitarrel  shall  be  granted  out  of  the 
archbishop's  courts  until  28  days  after  the 
presentation  has  been  tendered  to  the  bishop ; 
and  the  presentee  is  to  give  security  for  the 
costs  of  the  appeal.     [G.] 


E. 

EAGLE.  A  common,  and  the  most 
beautiful,  form  of  the  lectern  from  which 
the  lessons  are  read  in  churches.  It  has 
probably  some  reference  to  the  eagle,  which 
is  the  symbolical  companion  of  St  John, 
in  ecclesiastical  design.  The  eagle  is  fre- 
quently employed  in  foreign  churches,  but 
generally  for  the  chanting  of  the  service, 
not  for  the  lessons.  Sometimes  it  is  em- 
ployed for  the  reading  of  the  epistles  and 
gospels,  and  there  are  instances  of  one 
being  on  each  side  of  the  choir  or  chancel. 
Several  of  the  cathedrals  and  colleges  in 
our  universities  have  this  kind  of  lec- 
tern. Before  the  civil  wars  in  1651,  there 
was  in  the  cathedral  of  Waterford  a 
"great  standing  pelican  to  support  the 
Bible,  a  brazen  eagle,"  and  other  orna- 
ments.— Ryland's  Waterford.  At  Durham 
there  was  a  pelican,  on  the  north  side  of  the 
altar,  for  reading  the  Epistles  and  Gosjiels, 
and  a  brass  eagle  stood  in  the  choir  for  the 


310 


EAELY  ENGXISH 


lections.  The  "  Lecierna  "  or  Bible  eagle 
at  Peterborough  was  given  by  Abbot 
Eamsay  and  John  Maldon  in  1471.  There 
are  specimens  at  Winchester,  Lynn,  Wells, 
(1660),  York  (1686),  Canterbnry  (1663), 
Lincoln  (1667),  and  Salisbury  (1719).  The 
earliest  "eagle"  does  not  date  before  1300, 
but  it  was  often  previously  carved  in  front  of 
the  pulpit.— Dugd.  Monast.  ed.  1830,  i.  344  ; 
Jebb,  Choral  Service,  p.  195;  Walcott's 
Sac.  Arch.  p.  236.     [H.] 

EARLY  ENGLISH,  or  LANCET, 
the  first  style  of  pointed  arch  architecture, 
fully  established  about  1190,  and  merging 
in  the  Geometrical  about  1245.  The  Lan- 
cet window  is  the  principal  characteristic 
of  this  style  ;  but  it  has,  besides,  various  pe- 
culiarities (see  Arcade,  Capital,  Moulding, 
Vaidiing),  among  which  are  the  following : 
— The  door-ways  are  frequently  divided  by 
a  central  shaft.  As  compared  with  the  pre- 
ceding style,  the  buttresses  have  a  con- 
siderable projection,  and  they  usually  ter- 
minate in  a  plain  pediment.  The  flying 
buttress  becomes  frequent.  Gables  over 
high  walls  are  of  very  high  equilateral  pitch, 
and  about  pentagonal  over  lower  walls :  the 
parapet  is  more  common  than  in  Norman, 
and  usually  has  a  corbel-table.  Piers  con- 
sist of  a  circular  or  octagonal  shaft,  sur- 
rounded by  four  or  eight  smaller  ones,  which 
stand  free,  except  that,  when  of  great  length, 
they  are  generally  banded  in  the  centre.  Pur- 
beck  or  Petworth  marble  is  often  used  both 
for  the  central,  which  is  really  the  bearing 
shaft,  and  the  smaller  ones  ;  but  in  this  case 
the  marble  of  the  bearing  shaft  is  laid  as 
in  the  quarry,  while  the  smaller  shafts  are 
set  upwards,  for  the  sake  of  greater  length, 
and  they  do  no  real  work.  The  triforium 
still  maintains  its  importance,  though  hardly 
so  lofty  as  in  the  Norman  style :  it  is 
iisually  of  two  smaller  behind  a  principal 
arch,  or  of  four  smaller  behind  two  princi- 
pal arches.  The  clearstory  in  very  large 
churches  is  sometimes  of  the  three  Lancets, 
the  central  one  much  more  lofty  than  the 
two  others.  The  carving  is  extremely  sharp 
and  good,  and  very  easily  recognised  when 
it  contains  foliage,  by  the  stiff  stalks  end- 
ing in  crisped  or  curled  leaves.  Panels 
are  often  used  to  relieve  large  spaces  of 
masonry,  either  blank  or  pierced ;  and 
sometimes  in  window-heads,  and  in  tri- 
forium arcades,  approach  very  nearly  to 
the  character  of  tracery.  They  are  also 
often  filled  with  figures.  The  dog-tooth, 
which  had  made  its  appearance  in  the 
Transition,  is  now  extremely  abundant, 
often  filling  the  hollows  of  the  mouldings 
in  two  or  three  continuous  trails.  The 
spires  are  almost  invariably  broach-spires. 
The  proportions  of  arches  and  mouldings 
are  generally  best  in  this  style. 


EAST 

EAST  (Si;o  also  Hawing  and  Creed). 
In  the  aspect  of  their  churches.  Christians 
reversed  the  order  of  the  Jews,  placing  the 
altar  on  the  east,  so  thai  in  facing  towards 
the  altar  in  their  devotions  they  were  turned 
in  that  direction. 

L  In  the  ancient  Church  it  was  an  almost 
universal  practice  to  turn  the  face  to  the  east 
at  times  of  solemn  adoration,  which  custom 
seerasderivedfrom  the  ceremonies  of  baptism, 
when  it  was  usual  to  renounce  the  devil  with 
the  face  to  the  west,  and  then  turn  to  the  east 
and  make  the  covenant  with  Christ  (Jerome 
in  Amos  \i.  14 ;  Amb.  de  Initiatis.  2). 
Several  reasons  were  given  by  the  Fathers 
for  this,  amongst  others,  1.  As  the  Jews 
began  their  day  with  the  setting  sun,  so 
Christians  began  theirs  with  the  rising  sun  % 
the  east,  the  place  of  the  day-spring  from 
darkness,  being  the  symbol  of  Christ,  "  the 
Sun  of  righteousness"  (Tertul.conl  Valentin. 
c.  3 ;  Tertul.  Apol.  c.  16).  2.  As  the  east  was 
the  place  of  paradise,  lost  by  the  fall  of  the 
first  Adam,  and  to  be  regained  by  the  second 
Adam  (Clem.  Alex.  Strom,  vii.  p.  856  ; 
Basil,  de  Spir.  Sand.  c.  xxvii.).  3.  That 
Christ  made  His  appearance  on  earth  in  the 
east ;  there  ascended  into  heaven ;  and  thence 
will  again  come  at  the  last  day  (Athan. 
Qu8:st.  ad  Antioch.  qu.  37).  And,  4.  That 
the  east,  as  the  seat  of  light  and  brightness, 
was  the  most  honourable  part  of  the  creation, 
and  therefore  peculiarly  ascribed  to  God, 
the  fountain  of  light,  and  illuminator  of  all 
things  ;  as  the  west  was  ascribed  to  the 
devil,  because  he  hides  the  light,  and  brings 
darkness  on  men  to  their  destruction 
(Justin.  Quxst.  ad  Orthodox,  qu.  118). — 
Wheatly,  86. 

The  author  of  the  Apostolic  Constitutions 
enjoined,  "Let  the  building  be  with  its 
head  to  the  east ...  let  all  (the  catechumens 
and  penitents  being  gone  out)  pray  to  God 
eastward,  who  ascended  up  to  the  heaven 
of  heavens  to  the  east;  remembering  also 
the  ancient  situation  of  paradise  in  the  east, 
irom  whence  the  first  man  was  expelled " 
(Lib.  ii.  Ivii.).  "  When  we  stand  at  prayer," 
says  St.  Augustine,  "  we  turn  to  the  east 
whence  the  heaven  rises ;  not  as  if  God 
was  dwelling  there  only  in  the  sense  that 
He  Who  is  everywhere  present,  not  as 
occupying  space,  but  by  the  power  of  His 
Majesty,  had  forsaken  the  other  parts  of  the 
world ;  but  in  order  that  the  mind  may  be- 
admonished  to  turn  to  a  more  excellent 
nature,  i.e.  to  God,  where  its  own  body, 
which  is  earthly,  is  turned  to  a  more 
excellent  body,  i.e.  to  a  heavenly  one" 
{Serin,  on  Mount,  bk.  ii.  c.  v.  17). 

II.  The  turning  to  the  east  at  the  Creed  in 
the  English  Church,  is  a  survival  of  the 
ancient  general  custom,  dating  at  least  from 
the  time  of  TertuUian  in  the  second  century. 


EASTER  EVE 

In  the  recitation  of  the  Creed  as  the  symbo- 
lum  or  watchword  of  the  Christian  warfare, 
there  is  a  special  appropriateness  in  the  mar- 
shalling of  all,  as  one  army  of  Christ,  towards 
the  east  (Bp.  Bariy,  P.  B.  p.  47).  But  witli 
regard  to  this  custom  there  is  no  rubric: 
nor  is  there  one  directing  the  minister  to 
turn  to  the  people  when  reading  the  epistle 
and  gospel.  Therefore  it  seems  clear  that 
custom  was  thought  to  be  rule  enough— 
"  Mos  pro  lege."  In  the  Hereford  Use  the 
rubric  occurs  after  the  Creed.  ''  Quo  finito 
vertat  se  sacerdos  ad  populum  et  dicat,"  &o., 
shewing  that  when  reciting  tlie  Creed  his 
lace  was  not  towards  the  people. — Blunt's 
Par.  Priest,  sect.  x.  328.     [H.] 

EAS'l'ER  EVE.  The  Saturday  of  Holy 
Week.  It  was  called  in  the  early  Church,  both 
Eastern  and  Western,  "  the  great  Sabbath  " 
(to  liiya  ira^^aTov ;  Sabbatum  magnum). 
It  is  thus  described  in  the  Epistle  of 
the  Church  of  Smyrna,  where  an  account 
is  given  of  the  martyrdom  of  St.  Polycarp, 
who  was  apprehended  on  the  great  Sabbath 
(Euseb.  iv.  15.  12).  Early  writers  from 
Tertullian  downwards  speak  of  the  vigil  of 
Easter  as  observed  with  great  solemnity 
(Tertul.  ad  uxorem,  ii.  4) ;  the  churches  were 
lighted  up  "  so  that  it  seemed  like  day,"  as 
a  symbol  of  the  lighting  of  the  world  by 
the  Resurrection  of  ttie  Sun  of  Righteousness 
(Greg.  Naz.  Orat.  xlv.  in  Pasch. ;  Euseb.  de 
Vit.  Comt.  iv.  22).  There  was  also  a  tradition 
that  the  second  coming  of  our  Lord  would  be 
on  this  eve :  "  cujus  noctis  duplex  ratio  est, 
quod  in  ea  et  vitam  tum  recepit,  cum  passus 
est;  et  postea  orbis  terraj  regnum  recepturus 
est"  (Lactantius,  vii.  19;  Hieron.  iv.  in. 
Matt.  XXV.  6).  According  to  the  Apostolic 
Constitutions  this  was  the  only  Sabbath  on 
which  fasting  was  allowed  "for  inasmuch 
as  the  Creator  was  then  under  the  earth,  the 
sorrow  for  Him  is  more  forcible  than  joy  for 
the  creation "  (vii.  23).  This  was  the  chief 
day  for  baptising  the  catechumens,  as  being 
the  first  of  the  50  days  set  apart  for  tliis 
purpose,  and  accounted  but  as  one  solemn 
season  for  baptism  (St.  Chrys.  Ep.  i.  ad 
Innocent. ;  Bingham,  xi.  6).  On  the  "  great 
Sabbath"  after  the  deposition  of  St. 
Chrysostom,  there  were  3,000  catechumens 
awaiting  baptism  who  were  brutally  dispersed 
by  the  soldiery  (Stephens'  Life  of  St. 
Chrysostom,  p.  333,  2nd  ed.). 

The  ancient  collect,  epistle  and  gospel 
appointed  for  this  day  had  reference  to 
baptism.  In  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549  they 
were  changed,  but  the  present  collect  was 
not  inserted  till  1662.  It  is  based  on  the 
collect  in  the  Scotch  Liturgy  of  1637, 
commonly  attributed  to  Laud.  According 
to  the  ancient  offices  of  the  English  Church, 
the  Paschal  candle,  &c.,  received  benediction 
on  this  day  (See  Benediction).     [H.] 


EASTER 


311 


EASTKII.  The  Christian  Festival  ob- 
served in  memory  ot  our  Saviour's  Kesur- 
reotion.  The  Latins  and  others  call  it 
Pasoha  Qrrd<rx")  ^  word  derived  from  the 
Aramaic  form  of  the  Hebrew  name  for  Pass- 
over (nD5).  The  "  wd<Txa  oTavpaxriiMov,"  or 
Pasoha  Dominioas  Passionis,  was  the  same 
as  our  Holy  Week,  tlie  ncia-xa  ava<rra(nfiov, 
or  Pascha  Dominica;  Resurreotionis,  including 
Easter  and  the  days  witliin  the  octave. 
But  the  great  day  itself  was  the  Dies  Pascha;. 
The  name  was  once  familiar  in  England, 
and  in  the  north  Easter  eggs  are  called 
Paste-eggs,  or  Past-eggs — a  corruption  of 
pasch-eggs.  The  word  Easter,  according  to 
Bede,  is  derived  from  "  Eostre, "  a  goddess 
worshipped  in  Britain,  whose  festival  hap- 
pened about  the  time  of  the  vernal  equinox, 
and  her  name  is  probably  derived  from  the 
same  root  as  I^ast, — signifying  "to  shine" 
(De  Eatione  Temp.  xiii.  xv.).  From  the 
earliest  times  Christians  ail  agreed  in 
showing  a  peculiar  respect  and  honour  to 
this  festival.  Gregory  Nazianzen  calls  it 
the  Queen  of  Festivals  (j3a(n'Xi(r(ra  Toil' ^jiifpmi' 
fjfiepa),  and  says,  it  excels  all  others  as 
far  as  the  sun  exceeds  the  other  stars  {Or. 
xix.).  Hence,  in  some  ancient  writers,  it  is 
distinguished  by  the  name  of  Dominica 
Qaudii,  i.e.  the  "  Sunday  of  joy."  One 
great  expression  of  the  public  joy  was  given 
by  the  emperors,  who  were  wont  to  grant  a 
general  release  to  prisoners  on  this  day, 
with  an  exception  only  of  such  criminals  as 
were  guilty  of  the  highest  crimes  (Cod. 
Theod.  lib.  ix.  tit.  38 ;  Greg.  Nyssen,  Ho^n. 
iii.  de  Hcsur.  Christi).  The  ancient  Fathers 
frequently  mention  these  Paschal  indul- 
gences, or  acts  of  grace,  and  speak  of  them 
with  great  commendations.  It  was  likewise 
usual  at  this  holy  season  for  private  persons 
to  grant  slaves  their  freedom  or  manu- 
mission (Cod.  Justin,  iii.  tit.  12). 

To  these  expressions  of  public  joy  may  be 
added,  that  the  Christians  were  ambitious, 
at  this  time  especially,  to  show  then- 
liberality  to  the  poor.  Constantine  set  a 
good  example  in  this  respect  (Euseb.  Vit. 
Const,  iv.  22).  They  likewise  kept  the 
whole  week  after  Easter  day,  as  part  of  the 
festival ;  holding  religious  assemblies  every 
day,  for  prayer,  preaching,  and  receiving 
the  Communion  (Chrysost.  xxxiv.  de  Eesur. 
Christi).  Upon  which  account  the  author  of 
the  Constitutions  requires  servants  to  rest 
from  their  labour  the  whole  week  (viii. 
33).  All  public  games  were  prohibited 
during  this  whole  season ;  as  also  all  pro- 
ceedings at  law,  except  in  some  special  and 
extraordinary  cases  (Bingham,  xx.  v.  5). 

In  the  primitive  times  the  Christians  of 

all  Churches  on  this  day  used  this  morning 

salutation,   "  Christ    is    risen ; "    to    which 

I  those  who  were  saluted  answered,  "  Christ 


312 


EASTER 


is  risen  indeed;"  or  else  thus,  "and  hath 
appeared  unto  Simon;"  a  custom  still  re- 
tained in  the  Greek  Church.  And  our 
Church,  supposing  us  as  eager  of  the  joyful 
news  as  they  were,  is  loth  to  withhold  from 
us  long  the  pleasure  of  expressing  it;  and 
therefore,  as  soon  as  the  absolution  is 
pronounced,  and  we  are  thereby  rendered  fit 
for  rejoicing,  she  begins  her  ofSce  of  praise 
with  anthems  proper  to  the  day,  encouraging 
her  members  to  call  upon  one  another  "  to 
keep  the  feast ;  for  that  Christ  our  Passover 
is  sacrificed  for  us,  and  is  also  risen  from 
the  dead,  and  become  the  first-fruits  of  them 
that  slept, "  &c.— Wheatly,  c.  v.  p.  229. 

The  first  lesson  in  the  morning  is  the 
twelfth  chapter  of  Exodus,  in  which  is 
mentioned  the  institution  of  the  Passover, 
jjroper  for  this  day,  the  feast  of  the  Pass- 
over :  for,  as  St.  Augustine  observes,  "  we 
do  in  this  feast  not  only  call  to  mind  the 
history  of  our  Saviour's  resurrection,  but 
also  celebrate  the  mystery  of  ours."  Christ 
is  our  true  Passover,  whereof  the  other  was 
a  type:  the  lesson  then  is  proper  for  the 
day.  So  is  the  first  lesson  for  the  evening 
(Exod.  xiv.),  for  it  is  concerning  the 
Israelites'  deliverance  out  of  E^rypt,  a  type 
of  our  deliverance  from  hell  this  day  by 
Christ's  glorious  resurrection.  The  second 
lessons  are  plain.  The  Gospel  gives  us  the 
full  evidence  of  Christ's  resurrection:  the 
Epistle  tells  us  what  use  we  should  make 
of  it,  "  If  Christ  be  risen,  seek  those  things 
that  are  above, "  &o.  The  collect  prays  for 
grace,  to  make  the  use  of  it  which  the 
Epistle  directs. 

"  On  this  day,  as  on  Christmas  day,  there 
were  foraierly  [in  the  First  Book  of  King 
Edward  VI.]  two  communions,  whereof  we 
have  retained  the  former  Epistle  and  Gos- 
pel."— Bp.  Cosin.- 

II.  With  regard  to  the  time  of  the 
Festival,  though  all  agreed  in  the  obsei-va- 
tion  of  it  in  general,  yet  they  differed  very 
much  as  to  when  it  was  to  he  observed; 
some  keeping  it  precisely  on  the  same  stated 
day  every  year  ;  the  Church  of  Ephesus,  and 
the  Asiatic  Churches  dependent  on  it,  on  the 
fourteenth  day  of  the  first  moon  in  the  new 
year,  whatever  day  of  the  week  it  happened 
on  ;  and  others,  on  the  first  Sunday  after  the 
first  full  moon.  This  diversity  occasioned  a 
great  dispute,  in  the  second  century,  between 
the  Asiatic  Churches  and  the  rest  of  the 
world ;  in  the  course  of  which  Pope  Victor 
excommunicated  all  those  Churches.  But 
the  Council  of  Nice,  in  the  year  325,  decreed 
that  all  Churches  should  kee]j  the  Pasch,  or 
festival  of  Easter,  on  one  and  the  same  day, 
i\hich  should  be  always  a  Sunday.  It  was 
to  be  observed  on  the  Sunday  following  the 
Jewish  feast  of  the  Passover,  which  is  kept 
on  the  fourteenth  daj',  or  full  moon  of  the 


EASTER 

Jewish  month  Nisan.  This  decree  was 
aftenvards  confirmed  by  the  Council  of 
Antioch,  in  the  year  341.  Yet  this  did  not 
put  an  end  to  all  disputes  concerning  the 
observation  of  this  festival ;  for  it  was  not 
easy  to  determine  on  what  Sunday  it  was  to 
be  held,  because,  being  a  movable  feast,  it 
sometimes  happened  that  the  Churches  of 
one  country  kept  it  a  week,  or  a  month, 
sooner  than  other  Churches,  by  reason  of 
their  different  calculations.  Therefore  the 
Council  of  Nice  is  said  to  have  decreed 
further,  that  the  bishops  of  Alexandria 
should  adjust  a  proper  cycle,  and  inform 
the  rest  of  the  world  on  what  Sunday  every 
year  Easter  was  to  be  observed.  Notwith- 
standing which,  the  Roman  and  Alexandrian 
accounts  continued  to  differ,  and  sometimes 
varied  a  week,  or  a  month,  from  each  other : 
and  no  effectual  cure  was  found  for  this,  tiU, 
in  the  year  527,  Dionysius  Exiguus  brought 
the  Alexandrian  canon,  or  cycle,  entirely 
into  use  in  the  Roman  Church.  Meantime, 
the  Churches  of  Gaul  and  Britain  kept  to 
the  old  Roman  canon,  and  it  was  two  or 
three  ages  after,  before  the  new  canon — that 
is,  the  Alexandrian  canon — was,  not  without 
some  struggle  and  difficulty,  settled  among 
them. — Bingham,  Orig.  Eccles.  bk.  xx.  c.  5  ; 
Theod.  lib.  i.  c.  10 ;  Socrat.  lib.  ii.  c.  9  ; 
Euseh.  de  Vit.  Const,  lib.  iii.  c.  14 ;  Leo, 
Ep.  63,  ad  Marcian.  Imper  (See  Quarto- 
deciman). 

The  joaschal  canon,  or  rule,  of  Dionysius 
having  become  the  standing  rule,  for  the 
celebration  of  Easter,  to  all  the  Western 
Churches,  it  will  be  proper  briefly  to  explain 
it.  The  particulars  of  it  are  as  follows :  viz. 
that  Easter  be  always  on  the  Sunday  next 
after  the  Jewish  Passover ;  that,  the  Jewish 
Passover  being  always  on  the  fourteenth 
day  of  the  first  vernal  moon,  the  Christian 
Easter  is  always  to  be  the  next  Sunday  after 
the  said  fourteenth  day  of  that  moon ;  that, 
to  avoid  all  conformity  with  the  Jews  in 
this  matter,  if  the  fourteenth  day  of  the 
said  moon  be  on  a  Sunday,  this  festival  is  to 
be  deferred  to  the  Sunday  following ;  that 
the  first  vernal  moon  is  that  whose  fourteenth 
day  is  either  upon  the  day  of  the  vernal 
equinox,  or  the  next  fourteenth  day  after  it ; 
that  the  vernal  equinox,  according  to  the 
Council  of  Nice,  is  fixed  to  the  twenty-first 
day  of  March  ;  that  therefore  the  first  vernal 
moon,  according  to  this  rule,  is  that  whose 
fourteenth  day  falls  upon  the  21st  of  March, 
or  the  first  fourteenth  day  after ;  that  the 
next  Sunday  after  the  fourteenth  day  of 
the  venial  moon  (which  is  called  the  paschal 
term)  is  always  Easter  day ;  that,  therefore, 
the  earliest  paschal  term  being  the  21st  of 
March,  the  22nd  of  March  is  the  earliest 
Easter  possible ;  and  the  18th  of  April  being 
the  latest  paschal  tenn,  the  seventh  day 


EASTER  ANTHEMS 

after,  that  is,  the  25th  of  April,  is  the 
latest  Easter  possible ;  that  the  cycle  of  the 
moon,  or  golden  number,  always  shows  us 
the  first  day  of  the  paschal  moon,  and  the 
cycle  of  the  sun,  or  dominical  letter,  always 
shows  us  which  is  the  next  Sunday  after. — 
Prideaux,  Connect,  part  ii.  bk.  iv.  (See 
Smith  and  Cheetham's  Diet,  of  Christ. 
Ant.  p.  593). 

But  it  must  be  home  in  mind  that  it  is 
only  a  conventional  full  moon  tliat  regulates 
the  time  of  Easter  and  all  the  other 
movable  feasts,  and  not  the  i-eal  or  astro- 
aomical  full  moon  ;  which  indeed  would  bo 
impossible ;  for  even  in  the  eastern  parts  of 
England,  and  much  more  of  Europe,  the  full 
moon  near  midnight  may  be  a  nominal  day 
later  than  in  the  western,  as  midnight  comes 
sooner  in  the  east ;  and  Easter  might  have 
to  differ  as  much  as  five  weeks  in  two  places 
not  very  far  apart.  The  rules  on  which  this 
conventional  moon  depends  are  those  which 
were  invented  for  and  established  by  Pope 
Oregory  XIIL,  and  first  adopted  in  1582  in 
Popish  countries  with  the  general  reform  of 
the  Calendar,  and  in  this  country  in  1752, 
when  eleven  days  were  dropped  from  Sep- 
tember 2  to  September  14.  The  matter 
is  too  complicated  to  be  explained  here 
(See  Golden  Numbers,  and  Master  in  the 
English  Cydopiadia,  and  Sir  E.  Beckett's 
Astronomy  without  Matliematics,  and  the 
table  showing  all  the  Easters  for  four 
liundred  years  by  him  in  Whitaher's 
Almanack  for  1885).  The  rules  in  the 
Prayer  Book  for  finding  Easter  of  the 
years  before  1753  are  erroneous  ;  they  show 
what  it  would  have  been  if  the  new  style  had 
prevailed  always.     [H.] 

EASTEE  ANTHEMS.  On  Easter  day, 
instead  of  the  Venite,  certain  anthems  are 
appointed  to  be  said  or  sung.  At  the  last 
review  the  first  two  verses  now  used  were 
prefixed,  and  the  authorised  translation 
adopted.  In  the  First  Book  of  King 
Edward  YL,  these  anthems  were  appointed 
to  be  said  or  sung  "  afore  matins,  the  people 
being  assembled  in  the  church ;  "  and  were 
followed  by  the  subjoined  Versicle  and 
llesponse. 

Priest.  Show  forth  to  all  the  nations  the 
glory  of  God. 

Answ.  And  among  all  people  his  wonder- 
ful works. 
With  a  special  prayer.  The  present  rubric, 
substituting  these  anthems  for  the  Venite, 
ivas  introduced  in  1552. — Blunt's  Annot. 
1\  B.  i.  105. 

EBIONITES.  Heretics  in  the  first  and 
second  centuries,  who  had  their  origin  from 
the  circumcised  Christians,  who  liad  retired 
from  Jerusalem  to  Pella,  during  the  war 
between  the  Jews  and  Komans,  and  made 
tlieir  first  appearance  after  the  destruction 


EBIONITES 


313 


of  Jerusalem,  about  the  time  of  Domitian, 
or  a  little  before.  The  origin  of  the  name  is 
not  clearly  known.  Tertullian  speaks  of  a 
heretic  called  Ebion,  avIio  was  a  disciple 
of  Cerinthus,  and  added  to  the  errors  of  his 
master  (de  Prmsc.  Hxret.  xxxiii.  and  the 
Api^endix),  believing  with  him  that  Christ 
was  a  mere  man  (JDe  Cam.  Chr.  xviii.) 
(See  Cerinthians).  But  Origen  states  that 
"  the  Ebionites  derive  their  appellation  from 
their  condition  of  poverty,  for  Ebion  (JVpt?) 
means  'poor'  in  Hebrew"  (de  Frincip.  iv. 
22) ;  and  Irenajus  also  ignores  the  man,  when 
speaking  of  the  sect  ( Contra  Uteres,  i.  26). 
The  different  opinions  of  later  writers  are 
given  in  Barton's  Bampton  Lectures,  p.  496. 

The  Ebionites  held  the  same  errors  as  the 
Nazarenes.  They  united  the  ceremonies  of 
the  law  with  the  precepts  of  the  Gospel : 
they  observed  both  the  Jewish  Sabbath  and 
the  Christian  Sunday.  They  called  their 
place  of  assembling  a  synagogue,  and  not  a 
church.  They  bathed  every  day,  which  was 
the  custom  of  the  Jews.  In  celebrating  the 
Eucharist,  they  made  use  of  unleavened 
bread,  but  no  wine. 

Though  they  observed  the  law,  yet 
they  differed  from  the  Jews  in  many 
points.  They  acknowledged  the  sanctity  of 
Abraham,  Isaac,  Jacob,  Iiloses,  Aaron,  and 
Joshua ;  but  they  derided  those  who  came 
after  them.  They  rejected  some  parts  of 
the  Pentateuch ;  and  when  they  were  too 
closely  pressed  by  these  books,  they  entirely 
abandoned  them. 

They  added  to  the  observance  of  the  law 
divers  superstitions.  They  adored  Jerusalem 
as  the  house  of  God.  Like  the  Samaritans, 
they  would  not  suffer  a  person  of  another 
religion  to  touch  them.  They  abstained 
from  the  flesh  of  animals,  and  even  from 
milk:  and,  lest  any  one  should  object  to 
them  those  words  of  the  Gospel,  where  our 
Lord  says  he  desires  to  eat  of  the  passover, 
they  corrupted  the  passage. 

They  disagreed  among  themselves  with 
regard  to  our  Lord's  nature.  Some  of  them 
said  that  He  was  born,  like  other  men,  of 
Joseph  and  Mary,  and  acquired  sanctification 
only  by  His  good  works.  Others  allowed 
that  He  was  horn  of  a  virgin,  but  denied  that 
He  was  the  Word  of  God,  or  had  a  pre- 
existence,  before  this  human  generation. 
They  said  He  was  indeed  the  only  true 
prophet,  but  yet  a  mere  man,  who  by  His 
virtue  had  arrived  at  being  called  Christ  and 
the  Son  of  God.  They  supposed  that  Christ 
and  the  devil  were  two  principles,  which 
God  had  opposed  the  one  to  the  other. 

Of  the  New  Testament  they  acknow- 
ledged only  the  Gospel  of  St.  Matthew,  tliat 
is,  that  which  was  written  in  Hebrew,  and 
which  they  called  the  Gospel  according  to 
the  Hebrews.    But  they  took  from  it  the  two 


314 


ECCLESIASTES 


first  chapters,  and  corrupted  other  passages 
of  it.  They  absolutely  rejected  St.  Faul  as 
an  apostate,  and  an  enemy  of  the  law,  and 
published  several  calumnies  against  him. 
They  had  likewise  false  Acts  of  the  Apostles, 
in  which  they  mixed  a  great  many  fables. 

In  their  manner  of  life,  they  imitated 
the  Carpocratians,  the  most  infamous  of  all 
heretics.  They  rejected  virginity  and  con- 
tinence :  they  obliged  children  to  marry 
very  young  :  they  allowed  married  persons 
to  separate  from  each  other,  and  marry 
again,  as  often  as  they  pleased. 

St.  Justin,  St.  Irenseus,  and  Origen,  wrote 
against  the  Bbionites.  Epiphanius  treats  at 
length  of  them  in  his  Hsereses  (xxx.),  but  he 
mixes  other  sects  with  them.  "  The  cor- 
rectness of  Epiphanius  is  often  called  in 
question,  and  perhaps  justly.  But  if  the 
term  '  Ebionites '  designated  a  variety  of 
minor  sects — all  of  them  Jewish  Christians 
— who  had  imbibed  Gnostic  sentiments, 
unknown  to  the  original  Ebionites,  then 
Epiphanius  may  be  here  correct." — Stubbs' 
Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  92,  128,  140 :  ii.  66 ; 
Blunt's  Did.  of  Sects,  p.  138 ;  Eose's 
Neander,  ii.  10. 

ECCLESIASTES.  A  canonical  book  of 
the  Old  'I'estament.  It  is  called  "The 
words  of  the  Preacher,  the  Son  of  David, 
king  of  Jerusalem."  Nevertheless,  since 
the  days  of  Grotius  there  have  been  grave 
doubts  expressed  as  to  the  authorship  of 
this  book.  Words  occur  in  it  wliich  are 
alleged  to  be  of  a  later  date  than  Solomon, 
and  the  style  is  very  different  from  the 
Proverbs  and  Song  of  Songs.  Modem 
commentators,  however,  seem  generally  to 
assent  to  "  the  firm  and  unshaken  testimony 
of  primitive  tradition,  that  the  author  was 
Solomon  "  (See  Diet,  of  the  Bible  ;  Speaker's 
Commentary,  vol.  iv.  p.  62). 

ECCLES I  AST  1 C.  A  person  holding  any 
office  in  the  sacred  ministry  of  the  Church 
(See  Bishop,  Priest,  and  Deacon). 

ECCLESIASTICAL  HISTORIANS  (See 

jj'ist07"LCti')lSl 

ECCLESEASTICUS.  The  Latin  title  of 
an  apocryphal  book  of  Scripture,  distin- 
guished by  this  name  because  it  was  read 
(in  ecclesia),  and  which  was  called  in  the 
Septuagint  "  the  Wisdom  of  Jesus,  the  Son  of 
Sirach."  There  is  no  sign  of  the  use  of  the 
book  in  Justin  Martyr  ;  and  the  first  distinct 
quotations  occur  in  Clement  of  Alexandria. 
But  from  the  end  of  the  second  century  the 
book  was  much  used,  and  cited  with  respect. 
"While  it  is  destitute  of  the  highest 
canonical  authority,  it  is  a  most  important 
monument  of  the  religious  state  of  the  Jews 
at  the  perio<I  of  its  composition"  (circ. 
B.C.  200)  (Canon  Westcott :  Smith's  Diet, 
of  Bible,  i.  479). 

ECLECTICS.     A  sect  which  arose  m  the 


EDIFICATION 

Christian  Church  towards  the  close  of  the 
second  century.  They  professed  to  make 
truth  the  only  object  of  their  inquiry,  and 
to  be  ready  to  adopt  from  all  the  different 
systems  and  sects  such  tenets  as  they  thought 
agreeable  to  it,  and  to  digest  these  into  one 
consistent  doctrine ;  and  hence  their  name, 
from  ticXfyw,  to  select.  They  preferred  Plato 
to  the  other  philosophers,  and  looked  upon 
his  opinions  concerning  God,  the  human 
soul,  and  things  invisible,  as  conformable 
to  the  spirit  and  genius  of  the  Christian 
doctrine.  One  of  the  principal  patrons  of 
this  system  was  Ammonius  Saccas,  who  was. 
indeed  merely  a  sack  porter  to  the  corn- 
ships,  but  in  intellectual  influence  was  second 
only  to  St.  Clement  at  Alexandria.  He 
(a.d.  193-242)  laid  the  foundation  of  that 
sect,  afterwards  distinguished  by  the  name 
of  the  New  Platonists,  in  the  Alexandrian 
school. — Newman's  Arians,  i.  iv.,  London, 
1833;  Blunt's  Diet,  of  Sects,  141. 

ECONOMICAL.  The  economical  method 
of  disputing  was  that  in  which  the  disputants, 
accommodated  themselves,  as  much  as 
possible,  to  the  taste  and  prejudices  of  those 
whom  they  were  endeavouring  to  gain  over 
to  the  truth.  Some  of  the  early  Christians 
carried  this  condescension  too  far,  and  abused 
St.  Paul's  example  (1  Cor.  ix.  20).  The 
word  is  derived  from  otKovojila,  dispensatio 
reifamiliaris,  the  discretionary  arrangement 
of  things  in  a  house  according  to  circum- 
stances. It  signifies  to  do  a  thing  artfully 
and  dexterously,  or  with  cunning  and 
sagacity,  as  a  shrewd  manager  of  a  house- 
hold (plKov6fi.oi)  controls  those  under  him. 
As  a  curious  example  may  be  cited  the 
stratagem  by  which  St.  Chrysostom  effected 
the  capture  of  his  friend  Basil,  in  order  to 
force  him  into  a  bishopric  (See  St.  Chry- 
sostom, de  Sacerd.  i.  u.  9,  and  Life,  by  Eev. 
W.  R.  W.  Stephens,  p.  43  (2nd  ed.)). 

ECDMENICAL,  or  (ECUMENICAL 
(From  oIkoviicvt],  the  world').  A  term  applied 
to  general  councils  of  the  Church,  to  dis- 
tinguish them  from  provincial  and  diocesan 
synods  (See  Councils). 

EDIFICATION.  Literally,  a  building 
up ;  and  in  the  figurative  language  of  the 
New  Testament,  the  advancement  of  grace 
and  holiness,  whether  in  individuals  or  in 
the  Church  as  a  whole. 

A  pretence  of  greater  edification  has  been 
a  common  ground  of  separation  from  the 
Church;  but  most  absurdly,  for  "edi- 
fication, ''  says  Dean  Sherlock,  in  his  reso- 
lution of  some  cases  of  conscience  which 
respect  Church  communion,  "  is  building  up, 
and  is  applied  to  the  Church,  considered  as. 
God's  house  and  temple;  and  it  is  an  odd 
way  of  building  up  the  temple  of  God,  by 
dividing  and  separating  the  parts  of  it  frora 
each  other."     The  most  proper  signification. 


ECCLESIASTICAL 

of  the  Avord  which  our  tianslatoi's  render  by 
"edification,"  is  a  house  or  building;  and 
this  is  the  proper  sense  wherein  it  belongs 
to  the  Christian  Oiiurch:  "ye  are  God's 
husbandry,  ye  are  God's  building, "  that  is, 
the  Church  is  God's  house  or  building. 
Thus  the  same  apostle  tells  us  that  in 
Christ,  "  the  whole  building "  (that  is,  the 
whole  Christian  Chui-ch)  "  fitly  framed  to- 
gether, groweth  unto  an  holy  temple  in 
the  Lord"  (Ephes.  ii.  21).  Hence  the 
governors  of  the  Church  are  called  builders, 
and  the  apostles  are  called  "labourers  to- 
gether with  God, "  in  erecting  this  spiritual 
building ;  and  St.  Paul  calls  himself  a 
"master  builder."  Hence  the  increase, 
growth,  and  advances  towards  perfection  in 
the  Church,  are  called  the  building  or 
edification  of  it.  For  this  reason,  St.  Paul 
commends  ijrophecy,  or  expounding  the 
Scriptures,  in  preference  to  speaking  in 
■unknown  tongues  without  an  inteqireter, 
because  by  the  former  the  Church  receives 
building  or  edification. 

ECCLESIASTICAL  COMMISSION. 
This  most  important  body,  which  now  ad- 
ministers a  large  part  of  the  revenues  of  the 
Church  and  has  sundry  other  lunctions 
which  could  otherwise  only  be  performed  by 
continual  Acts  of  Parliament,  came  into 
existence  during  the  short  ministry  of  Sir 
K.  Peel  in  1835.  Just  before  the  meeting 
of  Parliament  the  Crown  issued  a  commission 
of  inquiry  to  the  two  archbishops,  Howley 
and  Vernon  Harcourt,  and  bishops  Blomfield, 
Kaye,  and  Monk,  the  Dean  of  Arches  (Sir 
H.  Jenner),  and  several  members  of  the 
Government,  who  were  directed  to  consider 
the  more  equal  distribution  of  episcopal 
revenues,  and  the  state  of  the  cathedrals 
"  with  a  view  to  the  suggestion  of  such 
measures  as  might  be  more  conducive  to  the 
efficiency  of  the  Church  by  providing  for  the 
cure  of  souls  and  by  preventing  pluralism." 
The  ministry  which  succeeded  in  April, 
1835,  issued  a  fresh  commission  changing 
the  oflicial  lay  members ;  and  they  made  the 
great  report  in  1836  which  was  turned  into 
an  Act  of  Parhament,  6  &  7  W.  IV.  c.  77,  the 
same  year,  which  did  in  a  great  measure 
equalise  the  incomes  of  all  the  bishops 
except  the  five  who  have  precedence  (see 
Bishops),  and  reduced  several  of  those  after 
the  existing  ones,  and  founded  the  sees  of 
Pipon.  and  Manchester,  leaving  the  sum 
of  the  episcopal  revenues  nearly  the  same  as 
before.  But  the  surplus  from  the  episcopal 
estates  soon  increased,  from  the  commis- 
sioners being  authorised  and  able  to  run 
out  leases  for  lives,  by  which  a  large  propor- 
tion of  the  property  of  the  Church  and  of 
colleges  had  been  continually  passing  away 
from  them,  as  no  temporary  owners  of  pro- 
perty so  based,  unless  younger  than  usual, 


ECCLESIASTICAL 


315 


could  afford  to  run  out  lenses.  And  even 
when  they  did,  they  were  generally  granted 
afresh  into  the  family  of  the  owners  for  a 
time,  or  else  an  enormous  fine  was  obtained 
lor  their  benefit  and  the  impoverishing  of 
their  successors  for  a  long  time.  A  great 
many  Acts  have  been  passed  for  them  for 
which  we  must  refer  the  reader  to  the  Index 
to  the  Statutes,  and  to  law  books.  The 
first,  in  1836,  established  the  body;  the 
second,  in  1840,  and  later  ones,  made  it  consist 
of  all  the  bishops,  the  deans  of  Canterbury, 
St.  Paul's,  and  Westminster ;  The  Lord  Chief 
Justice,  Master  of  the  Polls,  and  Dean  of 
Arches ;  five  Cabinet  Ministers,  and  now 
twelve  laymen  appointed  by  the  Crown,  two 
by  the  Archbishop  of  Canterbury — and  by  the 
Archbishop  of  York  none.  By  13  &  14  Vict. 
c.  94,  the  Crown  was  to  appoint  a  first  and 
second  "  estates  commissioner  "  of  whom  only 
die  first  has  a  salarj^  and  has  alwaj's  hitherto 
been  a  peer,  higher  than  a  baron,  and  the 
archbishop  a  third,  with  a  salary.  The 
"  estates  committee  "  is  to  consist  of  those 
three  and  two  more  appointed  by  the  general 
body,  of  whom  one  is  to  be  a  layman  not 
sitting  ex  officio.  Every  lay  member  must 
declare  that  he  is  a  member  of  the  Church  of 
England. 

By  the  Act  of  1850  the  surplus  of  the 
episcopal  estates  was  transferred  to  what  is 
inappropriately  called  the  Common  Fund, 
for  that  is  just  what  it  is  not,  as  all  the 
later  Acts,  after  1836,  for  founding  new 
bishoprics  actually  prohibit  the  application 
of  any  of  it  to  their  endowment  or  even  to 
providing  houses  for  them  or  buying  land 
therefor,  though  the  commissioners  may 
buy  it  for  anything  else,  and  do  constantly 
make  grants  lor  new  parsonages.  The  still 
stranger  thing  is  that  this  restriction  was 
not  imposed  by  any  external  interference  in 
Parliament,  but  was  volunteered  by  the 
commission  and  the  bishops  themselves 
under  the  fear  of  popular  cant  about  "working 
clergy,"  as  if  the  new  sees  were  not  founded 
because  they  were  wanted,  just  as  much 
as  Manchester  and  Eipon,  which  were 
founded  out  of  the  General  Fund  in  1836. 
The  commissioners  have  been  severely  criti- 
cised at  different  times  for  their  indiscreet 
purchases  and  sales  and  building  of  episcopal 
hou'jes,  of  course  under  the  guidance  of 
architects  and  surveyors.  And  they  made 
one  very  singular  mistake,  which  was  not 
discovered  till  too  late,  in  selling  the  separate 
estate  which  represented  old  York  House, 
the  London  residence  of  the  archbishop 
under  an  Act  of  James  I.,  who  took  it  in 
exchange  for  other  property  which  was  to 
provide  another  house,  and  in  fact  did  so  in 
income,  and  was  kept  apart  from  the  general 
property  of  the  see,  and  vested  for  that 
purpose  in  a  special  trust  during  vacancy 


S16 


ECCLESIASTICAL 


instead  of  the  income  going  to  tho  Crown. 
Moreover,  the  ArcliMshop  of  York  plainly 
ought  to  have  a  London  residence  at  least  as 
much  as  the  Bishop  of  Winchester,  who  gave 
it  up,  and  Ely,  who  retains  the  one  that  was 
buUt  for  him  instead  of  the  old  palace  and 
chapel  in  Ely  Place,  Holborn;  and  that 
mistake  about  York  House  ought  to  be 
rectified,  as  it  was  an  illegal  piece  of  con- 
tiscation. 

The  greater  part  of  their  income  arises 
from  the  Cathedral  Reform  Act  of  1840.  3 
&  4  Vict.  c.  113,  which  turned  into  a  statute 
the  further  report  of  the  Commission  for 
suppressing — or  (as  it  was  amended)  "  sus- 
pending "  as  to  income  all  the  non-residen- 
tiary canonries  or  prebends,  and  a  good  many 
residentiaries.  That  was  notoriously  Bishop 
Blomfield's  doing,  which  was  denounced 
mth  humorous  but  ineffective  vigour  by 
Sydney  Smith.  They  refused  an  amend- 
ment to  leave  rifled  canons  even  en- 
dowment enough  to  pay  their  expenses  of 
coming  to  preach  the  statutable  sermons  in 
their  trun.  And  though  a  great  parade 
was  made  of  equalising  bishops'  incomes, 
and  all  the  private  patronage  of  deans  and 
canons  was  transferred  to  the  bishops,  and 
all  the  separate  estates  taken  away,  many  of 
the  deaneries  were  left  with  incomes  utterly 
inadequate  for  their  houses,  and  for  the  duties 
of  a  dean.  All  which  Bishop  Blomfield  de- 
fended by  calling  it  "  a  holy  innovation  " ; 
but,  though  something  of  the  kind  was 
necessary,  it  by  no  means  followed  that 
whatever  the  holy  innovators  chose  to  do 
was  right,  as  they  expected  it  to  be  assumed. 

By  19  &  20  Vict.  c.  55,  the  ecclesiastical 
commission  was  made  also  the  church-build- 
ing commission,  whicli  had  been  established 
by  58  Geo.  III.  c.  45,  for  spending  the  mil- 
lion, afterwards  increased  to  one  and  a 
half  milUons  voted  by  Parliament  for  new 
churches,  before  the  dissenters  combined  to 
prevent  any  more  such  grants,  preferring 
the  spread  of  iofidelity  to  Christianity  taught 
by  the  Church,  as  they  did  afterwards  with 
schools.  It  is  impossible  to  give  any  full 
account  here  of  the  multitude  of  Acts  re- 
lating to  church  building  Qi-v.)  and  endow- 
ment and  the  creation  of  new  parishes,  for 
which  the  ecclesiastical  commission  have 
verylarge  powers,  and  by  29&  30  Viot.c.lll, 
confirmation  of  their  grants  by  the  Queen 
in  council  was  dispensed  with.  It  was  never 
more  than  a  mere  form. 

They  make  an  annual  report  of  all  their 
<iloings.  Applications  for  grants,  whether 
accompanied  with  offers  of  "  benefactions  " 
or  not,  have  generally  to  be  made  to  them 
in  November,  and  are  decided  on  in  the  fol- 
lowing spring.  By  23  &  24  Vict.  c.  142,  on 
every  avoidance  of  a  bishopric  thecommission 
may  revise  the  existing  arrangement  under 


ECCLESIASTICAL 

which  the  bishop  had  either  a  fixed  income 
from  them,  or  such  iwrtiou  of  the  episcopal 
estates  as  were  reckoned  to  produce  the  net 
income  prescribed  by  statute,  generally  the 
Act  of  1836.  By  31  &  32  Vict.  c.  114,  they 
may  arrauge  with  any  chapter  for  a  transfer 
of  all  or  part  of  the  capitular  property  for 
an  annual  money  payment,  or  vice  versa, 
for  transferring  lands  to  the  chapter  in 
consideration  of  any  annual  sum ;  and  at 
the  same  time  may  set  apart  as  part  of  the 
consideration  a  capital  sum  to  be  spent  in 
repairs,  restoration  and  improvement  of  the 
cathedral.  But  there  seems  to  be  no  power 
for  revising  these  arrangements  from  time 
to  time.     [Gr.j 

ECCLESIASTICAL  COURTS  COMMIS- 
SION. The  various  ecclesiastical  courts  are 
treated  of  under  the  heads  of  Chancellor's,  or 
Consistory,  or  Diocesan  Courts,  Arches(_Court 
of).  Judicial  Committee  of  the  Prioy  Council, 
and  also  Delegates,  which  were  superseded 
thereby.  But  'it  raa,y  be  convenient  here  to 
notice  the  Hoyal  Commission  on  Eccle- 
siastical Courts  which  was  issued  in  1881. 
It  was  originall}^  composed  of  twenty-five 
commissioners,  being  the  two  Archbishops, 
the  Bishops  of  Winchester,  Oxford  and 
Truro,  the  Mai-quess  of  Bath,  the  Earls  of 
Devon  and  Chichester,  Lords  Penzance, 
Blachford,  Coleridge,  Sir  R.  G.  Phillimore, 
Sir  R.  A.  Cross,  Sir  W.  C.  James,  W.  C. 
Lake,  Dean  of  Durham,  J.  J.  S.  Perowne, 
Dean  of  Peterborough,  Professors  Westcott 
and  Stubbs,  Dr.  Deane,  E.  A.  Freeman, 
Esq.,  Rev.  Dr.;  Espin,  Rev.  A.  C.  Ainslie, 
Arthur  Charles,  Esq.,  P.  H.  Jeune,  Esq.,  and 
Samuel  Whitbread,  Esq.  After  the  death 
of  Archbishop  Tait,  the  Bishop  of  Truro 
became  Primate,  and  his  original  place  on 
the  Commission  was  not  filled  up,  so  that  the 
whole  number  was  reduced  to  twenty-four. 
The  Commission  was  appointed  to  "  inquire 
into  the  constitution  and  working  of  the 
Ecclesiastical  Courts,"  in  consequence  of  a 
very  widespread  dissatisfaction  in  regard  to 
these  courts,  more  especially  since  the  passing 
of  the  Pubhc  Worship  Regulation  Act  in 
1874.  The  sittuigs  of  the  Commissioners 
extended  over  two  ye.ars.  A  large  number 
of  witnesses  were  examined  in  order  to 
ascertain  the  causes  and  extent  of  the  pre- 
valent dissatisfaction,  a  careful  inquiry  was 
made  into  the  constitution  and  procedure  of 
ecclesiastical  courts  in  other  Churches  in 
different  parts  of  the  world,  whether  in 
communion  with  the  Church  of  England  or 
not,  whether  established  or  non-established ; 
and  the  history  of  the  Church  Courts  in 
England  was  investigated  from  the  earliest 
times.  I'he  main  results  of  these  inquiries 
were  embodied  in  the  Report  of  the  Com- 
mission; but  the  history  of  the  English 
Ecclesiastical   Courts  was  traced  most  mi- 


ECCLESIASTICAL 

nutely  and  exliaustively  in  an  Appendix 
written  by  the  present  Bishop  of  Chester, 
Dr.  Stubbs. 

The  recommendations  of  the  Commis- 
sioners were  placed  at  the  end  of  their 
Eeport ;  and  the  most  important  of  them 
are  as  follows : 

(1)  That  alike  in  cases  of  misconduct  and 
neglect  of  duty,  and  in  cases  of  heresy  and 
breach  of  ritual,  the  promoters  of  the  suit 
must  obtain  the  bishop's  assent  to  their 
proceedings. 

(2)  That  suits  imder  either  head  shall 
be  brought  in  the  first  instance  into  the 
diocesan  court,  which  shall  consist  of  the 
bishop  with  a  legal  assessor  in  cases  of  mis- 
conduct, and  with  a  legal  and  theological 
assessor  in  cases  of  heresy  and  ritual. 

(3)  That  an  appeal  shall  lie  from  the 
diocesan  court  to  the  court  of  the  province, 
which  shall  consist  of  the  official  principal. 

(4)  That  an  appeal  shall  lie  from  the 
court  of  the  province  to  the  Crown,  and  the 
Crown  shall  appoint  a  pennanent  body  of 
lay  judges  learned  in  the  law  to  whom  such 
appeals  shall  be  referred.  Every  person  so 
ai^pointed  shall  before  taking  office  make 
and  sign  a  solemn  declaration  that  he  is  a 
member  of  the  Church  of  England  as  by 
law  established.  The  number  summoned 
for  each  case  shall  not  be  less  than  five,  to 
be  summoned  by  the  Lord  Chancellor  in 
rotation.  The  judges  shall  have  the  power 
of  consulting  ihe  archbishop  and  bishops  of 
the  province,  if  thought  advisable,  and  shall 
be  bound  so  to  consult  them  on  the  demand 
of  any  one  or  more  of  their  number  present 
at  the  hearing  of  the  appeal. 

(5)  That  the  actual  decree  shall  he  alone 
of  binding  authority :  the  reasoning  of  the 
written  or  oral  judgments  shall  always  be 
allowed  to  be  reconsidered  and  disputed. 

(6)  That  the  official  principals  of  the 
provincial  courts  shall  be  appointed  by  the 
archbishops,  who  may,  if  they  think  fit, 
appoint  the  same  person  to  act  for  both 
provinces.  An  official  principal  shall  be  one 
who  is  or  has  been  a  lord  of  appeal,  or  has 
been  a  judge  of  the  Supreme  Court  of  Judi- 
cature, or  has  been  in  actual  practice  as  a 
barrister-at-law  for  ten  years.  He  shall  be 
appointed  during  good  behaviour,  and  before 
entering  on  his  office  shall  make  and  sign  a 
declaration  that  he  is  a  member  of  the 
Church  of  England;  and  shall  take  the 
oaths  and  make  the  declaration  required  by 
the  127th  Canon  of  1604. 

The  Eeporc  was  signed  by  twenty-three 
Commissioners,  although  fourteen  qualified 
their  assent  by  certain  reservations,  of  which 
the  most  important  were :  (i.)  an  objection 
to  the  assent  of  the  bishop  being  required  as 
an  indispensable  condition  to  legal  pro- 
ceedings  (signed    by   Lord    Coleridge,   the 


ECCLESIASTICAL 


31i7 


Archbishop  of  York,  J.  J.  Stewart  Pcrownc, 
and  E.  H.  Jeune) ;  (ii.)  an  objection  to  the 
Final  Court  of  Appeal  consisting  of  lay 
judges  appointed  by  the  Crown  (signed  by  Sir 
a.  PhiUimore).  Lord  Penzance,  who  had 
been  prevented  by  illness  from  attending 
the  meetings  regularly,  appended  a  sepa- 
rate report.  He  came  to  the  conclu- 
sion "  that  there  is  no  warrant  to  be  found 
in  the  legal  or  constitutional  history  of  thi» 
country  for  the  proposition  that  there  have 
existed  at  any  time  since  the  Conquest,  or 
indeed  before  it,  spiritual  courts  deriving 
their  original  authority  from  the  Church,  inr 
dependent  of  the  Sovereign  or  the  State,  and 
that  the  authority  for  the  jurisdiction  of  the 
existing  ecclesiastical  courts  did,  on  the 
contrary,  emanate  directly  from  the  Cro-ivn." 

(Eeport  under  tlie  Eoyal  Commission,  p. 
53  \  '■ 

ECCLESIASTICAL  TITLES  ACT.  In. 
1850  a  great  commotion  was  raised  by  Pope 
Pius  IX.  giving  to  the  Popish  bishops  in 
England  and  Ireland  titles  taken  from 
various  places  therein,  such  as  Westminster, 
Beverley,  &c.,  instead  of  "  Melipotamus  (and 
other  such  names)  in  partibus  infidelium." 
And  it  was  aggravated  by  a  bombastic  ma- 
nifesto "  issued  out  of  the  Flaminian  Gate  " 
by  Dr.  Wiseman,  who  was  thus  translated 
from  Mehpotamus  to  the  archbishopric  of 
Westmmster.  Thereupon  Lord  J.  Eussell 
introduced  a  Bill  in  1851,  which  was  passed 
with  little  opposition,  to  make  the  assump- 
tion or  use  of  such  titles  penal,  as  well  aa 
illegal ;  because  the  use  by  Englishmen  of  all 
titles  conferred  by  foreign  states  is  without 
royal  licence.  No  such  rank  as  Cardinal 
has  any  legal  recognition  here,  and  the 
Queen  once  cancelled  a  presentation  at 
Court  of  some  English  Koman  ecclesiastic 
under  the  title  of  Monsignor  which  had 
passed  inadvertently  through  the  Lord 
Chamberlain's  office.  Mr.  Gladstone  was 
one  of  the  opponents  of  the  Act  of  1851,. 
and  just  20  years  after,  being  Prime  Min- 
ister, got  it  repealed  with  equally  little- 
opix)sition.  But  the  repealing  Act  contains 
a  proviso  that  "such  repeal  is  not  to  ho 
deemed  in  any  way  to  authorise  or  sanction 
the  conferring  or  attempting  to  confer  any 
rank,  title,  or  precedence,  authority  or  juris- 
diction, on  or  over  any  subject  of  this  realm 
by  any  person  out  of  this  realm  other  than, 
the  Sovereign  thereof"  AVe  set  this  out  in. 
full  because  there  are  occasionally  discus- 
sions, founded  on  ignorance  of  the  law,, 
whether  precedence  should  be  given  to 
Romish  bishops.  They  have  none  at  all. 
ds  such:  nor  have  the  bishops  of  the 
Church  in  Scotland  or  Ireland  now,  nor 
suffragans,  beyond  what  may  be  given  them 
by  courtesy,  as  is  often  done  to  bishops'  mvea- 
in  England,  at  least  in  their  own  diocese  j 


S18 


EDMUND 


but  our  Scotch  and  Irish  bishops  are  recog- 
nised by  sundry  Acts  of  Parliament  (See 
Church  in  Scotland  and  Ireland).     [G.] 

EDMUND.  King  and  Martyr:  com- 
memorated on  Nov.  20.  He  was  bom  a.d. 
841,  and  succeeded  to  the  throne  of  East 
Angha  at  an  early  age.  He  bravely  with- 
stood the  Danes,  but  was  by  them  defeated 
and  taken  prisoner.  The  Danes  offered  him 
his  life  and  his  kingdom  if  he  would 
renounce  Christianity,  but  he  refused  and 
was  burnt  to  death,  being  tied  to  a  tree  and 
shot  at  with  arrows.  An  abbey  was  built 
-upon  the  spot  where  his  remains  were  buried 
(at  St.  Edmund's  Burgh),  and  was  afterwards 
refounded  in  his  honour  by  King  Cnut.  [H.] 

EDUCATION,  ELEMENTARY.  After 
the  Education  Act  of  1870,  it  was  a  question 
whether  schools  on  a  Church  basis  would  be 
able  to  hold  their  own.  The  Society  for  the 
Promotion  of  Chiistian  Knowledge,  and 
the  National  Society,  at  once  extended  their 
help  ;  and  by  the  earnest  work  of  the  clergy, 
backed  by  these  two  great  Church  Societies, 
the  Church  schools  still  show  the  Idghest 
average,  both  with  regard  to  attendance  and 
contributions.  The  following  lists  speak  for 
themselves. 

Accommodation, 


Day  Schools,  Year 
euded  August  31 

1883 

1884 

1885 

Churr.h      .... 
British,  &c.  .     .     . 
Wesleyan      .     .     . 
Roman  Catholic 
Board 

2,413,676 
386,839 
200,564 
272,760 

1,396,604 

2,454,788 
394,009 
203,253 
284,614 

1,490,174 

2,505,477 
395,104. 
204,879 
292,450 

1,600,718 

4,670,443 

4,826,738 

4,998,718 

VOLUXTAET  COKTalBUTIONS. 

Day  Schools, 
Year  ended 
Angnst  31 

1883 

1884 

1885 

Church .     . 
British,  &c. 
"Wesleyan  . 
£x)man     Ca- 

thoUc     . 
Board    .     . 

£         s.    d. 

577,313  16    6 

71,519    2     9 

15,271  14    1 

61,564  15    2 
1,420     1     3 

£           s.  d. 

585,071  11  10 

72,973  10     0 

16,802    2    0 

57,672     1    2 
1,603    7  10 

f           I.   d. 

583,936     3     4 

96,832    6    3 

15,934    1  11 

59,233    8  10 
891  11  11 

717,039    9    8 

734,127  12  10;756,827  18    3 

Even  theso  figures,  it  must,  however,  be 
noted,  give  a  very  imperfect  impression  of 
the  work  of  the  Schools  of  the  Church  of 
England  and  of  tlie  Voluntary  Schools 
generally.  Going  back  for  a  moment  to  the 
year  1870,  it  is  to  be  observed  that  during 
the  fifteen  years  which  have  since  elapsed 
the  aocommorlation  in  Elementary  Schools 
has  been  nearly  trebled.  The  School  Board 
system  and  the  Voluntary  system  have  been 
at  work  side  by  side :  and  while  the  School 
JBoards,  with  their  practically  unlimited  re- 


ELDERS 

sources,  have  provided  accommodation  for 
1,600,718  children,  Christian  zeal  and 
energy,  unaided  by  the  rates,  have,  in  ex- 
actly the  same  period,  provided  accommo- 
dation for  1,519,416,  of  which  1,150,690  are 
due  to  the  Church.  The  Church  alone  had, 
in  1885,  nearly  one  million  more  school 
places  than  are  provided  in  Board  Schools. — 
Beport  of  Nat.  Soc.  1886.     [H.] 

EDWARD,  son  of  Eadgar  the  Peaceful, 
king  of  the  West  Saxons,  was  crowned  by 
Dunstan  a.d.  975,  and  murdered  by  order 
of  his  steji-mother  Elfrida  on  March  18, 
978,  on  which  day  he  is  commemorated  in 
the  Calendar.  His  remains  were  translated 
from  Wareham  to  Shaftesbury  on  June  20, 
980.— Lingard,  i.  231.     [H.] 

EDWARD  THE  CONFESSOR, 
TRANSLATION  OF.  Commemorated 
Oct.  13.  Edward  succeeded  his  father.  King 
Ethelred,  in  a.d.  1041.  He  re-established 
the  ancient  Abbey  of  Westminster  in  a 
magni  ficent  manner.  The  buildings  (not  the 
present  church,  of  which  the  greater  part  is 
nearly  two  centuries  later)  were  completed 
and  solemnly  dedicated  to  St.  Peter  on  the 
Feast  of  Holy  Innocents,  a.d.  1065,  but 
Edward  was  not  able  to  be  present,  as  he 
was  "  sick  unto  death."  He  died  Jan.  5, 
A.D.  1066,  and  was  buried  in  the  new  Abbey 
Church  before  the  high  altar.  His  tomb  was 
richly  adorned  by  William  L,  and  enclosed 
in  a  shrine.  The  body  was  removed  by 
St.  Thomas  of  Canterbury  to  a  richer 
shrine,  Oct.  13,  a.d.  1163 ;  and  after  the 
rebuilding  of  the  church  by  Henry  HI.  a, 
most  sumptuous  shrine  was  erected,  a 
portion  of  which  still  remains.  Edward, 
though  not  perhaps  a  great  king,  must  be 
ranked  among  the  best  princes  of  his  time. 
The  goodness  of  his  heart  was  adored  by  his 
subjects,  who  lamented  his  death  with  great 
grief,  and  bequeathed  his  memory  as  an 
object  of  veneration  to  their  posterity. — 
Lingard,  i.  276,  399  (See  Oranvp  Rings), 

EDWARD  VL,  PRAYER  BOOKS  OP 
(See  Prayer  Book). 

ELDEKS  (jvptcr^vTepoi,  hence  Pres- 
byterians). Presbyterian  sects  have  sup- 
posed that  the  order  of  lay-elders,  as  they 
denominate  some  of  their  officers,  is  sanc- 
tioned by  Holy  Scripture.  It  appears 
certain,  however,  that  the  "elders"  men- 
tioned by  St.  Paul  (1  Tim.  v.  1,  17)  did  not 
hold  the  same  office  as  those  in  the  Presby- 
terian sects,  but  "  laboured  in  the  word  and 
doctriue."  In  this  place  the  apostle  means 
simply,  ordained  ministers,  when  he  directs 
that  double  honour  should  be  paid  to  tlie 
elders  that  rule  well,  especially  those  who 
labour  in  the  word  and  doctrine;  and  the 
distinction  does  not  appear  to  consist  in  the 
order  of  officers,  but  in  the  degree  of  their 
diligence,    faithfulness,    and    eminence    in 


ELECTION 

laboriously  fulfilling  their  ministerial  duties. 
It  is  said  tliat  Calvin  admitted  lay-elders  into 
Church  courts,  on  what  ho  conceived  to  be 
tlie  sanction  of  primitive  practice,  and,  as  an 
eflfectual  method  of  preventing  the  return  of 
inordinate  power  in  a  superior  order  of  the 
clergy.  To  this  it  is  answered  by  Catholics, 
that  neither  the  name  nor  office  of  lay-elder 
was  ever  known  to  any  general  or  provincial 
council,  or  even  to  any  particular  Church 
in  the  world,  before  the  time  of  Calvin 
(See  Presbyterians). 

ELECTION  (See  Predestination,  Cal- 
vinism, Arminiardsm) .  There  are  three 
views  taken  of  election,  all  parties  agreeing 
that  some  doctrine  of  election  is  taught  in 
Holy  Scripture, — the  Calvinistic,  the  Ar- 
nrinian,  aud  the  Catholic. 

I.  B}^  the  Calvinists  (see  Calvinism),  elec- 
tion is  judged  to  be  the  election  of  certain 
individuals  out  of  the  great  mass  of  man- 
kind, directly  and  immediatelj',  to  eternal 
life,  while  all  other  individuals  are  either 
Ijassively  left,  or  actively  doomed,  to  a  cer- 
tainty of  eternal  death  ;  and  the  moving 
cause  of  that  election  is  defined  to  be  God's 
unconditional  aud  irrespective  will  and  plea- 
sure, inherent  in,  and  exercised  in  conse- 
quence of.  His  absolute  and  uncontrollable 
sovereignty. 

II.  By  the  Arminians,  or  Remonstrants 
(see  Arminianism),  Scriptural  election  is  pro- 
nounced to  be  the  election  of  certain  indi- 
vidualt:,  out  of  the  great  mass  of  mankind, 
directly  and  immediately  to  eternal  life ; 
and  the  moving  cause  of  that  election  is 
asserted  to  be  God's  eternal  prevision  of 
the  future  preserving  holiness  and  con- 
sequent moral  fitness  of  the  individuals 
themselves,  who  thence  have  been  thus 
elected. 

III.  Election  under  the  gospel  or  Catholic 
view  denotes,  the  election  of  various  indi- 
viduals into  the  pale  of  the  visible  Church, 
with  God's  merciful  purpose,  that  through 
faith  and  holiness  they  should  attain  ever- 
lasting glory,  but  with  a  possibility  (since 
God  oroverns  his  intelUgent  creatures  on 
moral  principles  only)  that  through  their 
own  perverseness  they  may  fail  of  attain- 
ing it. 

Stanley  Faber,  from  whose  work  {The  Pri- 
mitive Doctrine  of  Election.  1842)  these  defi- 
nitions are  taken,  very  clearly  proves  this  to 
be  the  doctrine  of  the  reformed  Church  of 
En<'land :  where,  in  the  seventeenth  Article, 
the°Churoh  of  England,  speaking  of  predes- 
tination to  hfe,  teaches  not  an  election  of 
certain  individuals,  either  absolute  or  pre- 
visional,  directly  and  immediately,  to  eter- 
nal happiness.  But  she  teaches  an  election 
of  certain  individuals  into  the  Church 
Catholic,  in  order  that  there,  according  to 
the  everlasting  purpose  and  morally  oper- 


ELECTION 


319 


ating  intention  of  God,  they  may  be  de- 
livered from  curse  aud  damnation,  and 
thus,  indirectly  and  mediately,  may  be 
brought,  through  Christ,  to  everlasting 
glory;  agreeably  to  God's  promises,  as 
they  are  generically,  not  specificall}^  set 
forth  to  us  in  Holy  Scripture. 

IV.  That  such  is  the  real  doctrine  of  the 
Chm-ch  of  England — in  other  words,  that 
she  teaches  a  predestination  to  life,  not 
direct  and  immediate,  but  indirect  and 
mediate — inevitably  follows  from  the  cir- 
cumstance that,  while  in  her  sixteenth 
Article  she  hints  at  the  possibility  of  the 
elect  individually  departing  from  grace 
given,  in  her  Homilies  and  in  her  Burial 
Service  she  distinctly  states,  that  the  elect, 
in  her  sense  of  the  word,  may,  in  their  in- 
dividual capacity,  fall  away  utterly,  and 
thus  perish  finally.  Now,  this  statement 
is  palpably  incompatible  with  the  tenet  of 
a  direct  and  immediate  predestination  of 
individuals  to  eternal  life ;  for  individuals, 
so  predestinated,  could  not,  by  the  verj' 
tei-ms  of  their  predestination,  fall  away 
utterly  and  irrecoverably.  Therefore,  the 
predestination  to  hfe,  mentioned  in  the 
seventeenth  Article,  cau  only  mean  an  in- 
direct and  mediate  predestination  of  indi- 
viduals; or,  in  other  words,  it  can  only 
mean  a  predestination  of  individuals  to 
eternal  life,  through  the  medium  of  elec- 
tion into  the  Catholic  Church ;  in  God's 
everlasting  purpose  and  intention  indeed ; 
but  still  (since  God,  in  executing  His  pur- 
pose and  intention,  operates  upon  the 
minds  of  His  intelligent  creatures  not  phy- 
sically, but  morally,)  with  a  possibility  of 
their  defeating  that  merciful  purpose  .and 
intention,  and  thence  of  their  finally  fall- 
ing away  to  everlasting  destruction. 

As  the  article,  in  connexion  with  the 
other  documents  of  the  Anglican  Church, 
must,  unless  we  place  them  in  irrecon- 
cilable collision  with  each  other,  be  under- 
stood to  propound  the  doctrine  of  predes- 
tination after  the  manner  and  in  the  sense 
which  has  been  specified ;  so  it  distinctly 
enjoins  us  to  receive  God's  promises,  as 
they  are  generally  set  forth  to  us  in  Holy 
Scripture. 

The  word  generally  in  this  place  is  not 
opposed  to  unusually,  but  to  particularly, 
and  signifies  generically.  And  the  other 
documents  of  the  Church  of  England  agree 
with  this  interpretation  of  this  seventeenth 
Article. 

We  may  refer,  in  the  first  instance,  to 
the  peculiar  phraseology  introduced  into 
the  office  of  Infant  Baptism.  "  Regard,  we 
beseech  thee,  the  supplications  of  thy  con- 
gregation :  sanctify  this  water  to  the  mys- 
tical washing  away  of  sin :  aud  grant  that 
this  child,  now  to  loe  baptised  therein,  may 


320 


ELECTION 


receive  the  fulness  of  thy  grace,  and  ever  re- 
main in  the  number  of  tliy  faithful  and  elect 
children ;  through  Jesus  Christ  our  Lord." 

Thus,  in  systematically  generalizing 
phraseology,  runs  the  prayer.  Now  the 
same  prayer  is  recited  over  every  child. 
Consequently,  by  the  inevitable  force  of 
the  -word  "remain"  as  here  used,  every 
child,  baptismally  brought  into  the  pale  of 
the  Church,  is  declared  to  be,  at  that  time, 
one  of  the  number  of  God's  elect. 

But  the  largest  charity  cannot  believe 
that  every  child,  baptismally  brought  into 
the  pale  of  the  Church,  is  elect  in  the 
sense  of  election  as  jointly  maintained  by 
Calvin  and  Arminius. 

Therefore,  agreeably  to  the  tenor  of  her 
own  explicit  phraseology,  the  idea  which 
the  English  Church  annexes  to  the  term 
election,  can  only  be  that  of  ecclesiastical 
individual  election. 

The  matter  is  yet  additionally  estab- 
lished by  the  parallel  phraseology,  which 
occurs  in  the  somewhat  more  modern  office 
of  Adult  Baptism. 

With  the  sole  requisite  alteration  of 
"this  person"  for  "this  child,"  the  prayer 
is  copied  verbatim  from  the  older  office. 
Every  adult,  therefore,  who  is  baptismally 
introduced  into  the  pale  of  the  Church,  is, 
as  such,  declared  to  be  one  of  the  number 
of  God's  elect  people. 

The  same  matter  is  still  further  estab- 
lished by  the  strictly  homogeneous  lan- 
guage of  the  Catechism. 

Each  questioned  catechumen,  who,  as 
an  admitted  member  of  the  Church,  has 
already,  in  the  baptismal  office,  been  de- 
clared to  be  one  of  the  elect,  is  directed  to 
reply :  that,  as  a  chief  article  of  the  faith 
propounded  in  the  Creed,  he  has  learned 
"  to  believe  in  God  the  Holy  Ghost,  who 
sanctifieth  "  him  "  and  all  the  elect  people 
of  God." 

Now,  such  an  answer  plainly  makes 
every  catechumen  declare  himself  to  be  one 
of  the  elect. 

But,  in  no  conceivable  sense  which  will 
harmonize  with  the  general  phraseology  of 
the  Anglican  Church,  save  in  that  of  eccle- 
siastical individual  election  only,  can  every 
catechumen  be  deemed  one  of  God's  elect 
people. 

Therefore  the  idea  which  to  the  Scrip- 
tural term  election  is  annexed  by  the 
Church  of  England,  is  that  of  ecclesiastical 
individual  election. 

The  matter  is  also  established  by  the 
parallel  phraseology  introduced  into  the 
Burial  Service. 

"  We  beseech  thee,  that  it  may  please 
thee,  of  thy  gracious  goodness,  shortly  to 
accomplish  the  number  of  thine  elect,  and 
to  hasten  thy  kingdom;  that  we,  with  all 


ELEMENTS 

those  that  are  departed  in  the  true  faith  of 
thy  holy  name,  may  have  our  perfect  con- 
summation and  bliss,  both  in  body  and 
soul,  in  the  eternal  and  everlasting  glory, 
through  Jesus  Christ  our  Lord." 

In  this  prayer,  the  generic  term  "we" 
occurs  in  immediate  connexion  with  "the 
number  of  thine  electa 

Therefore  the  evidently  studied  arrange- 
ment of  the  words  enforces  the  conclusion 
that  every  member  of  the  Church,  as  de- 
signated by  the  term  "  we,"  must  be  deemed 
one  of  God's  elect  people. 

Finally,  the  same  matter  is  established, 
even  in  the  familiar  course  of  daily  recita- 
tion, by  the  language  of  the  very  liturgy  itself. 

"Endue  thy  ministers  with  righteous- 
ness :  and  make  thy  chosen  people  joyful. 

"  0  Lord,  save  thy  people :  and  bless- 
thine  inheritance." 

Now,  who  are  the  "  chosen  people  '^ 
whom  the  Lord  is  here  supplicated  to 
"  make  joyful"  ? 

Can  we  reasonably  pronounce  them,  in. 
the  judgment  of  the  Anglican  Church,  to 
be  certain  individuals  of  each  actually 
praying  congregation,  who,  in  contradis- 
tinction to  other  individuals  of  the  same 
congregation,  are  predestinated,  either  ab- 
solutely or  previsionally,  to  eternal  life  ? 

Assuredly,  the  whole  context  forbids  so 
incongruous  a  supposition;  for,  assuredly, 
the  whole  context  requires  us  to  pro- 
nounce, that  "  thy  chosen  people "  are 
identical  with  "  thine  inheritance." 

But  the  whole  tenor  of  the  Prayer  Book 
identifies  "  thine  inheritance  "  with  the  Ca- 
tholic Church. 

Therefore,  "  thy  chosen  people  "  and  the 
Catholic  church  are  terms,  in  point  of 
import,  identical  (See  Perseverance). 

ELECTION  OF  BISHOPS  (See  Mslwps). 

ELEMENTS.  The  materials  used  in  the 
sacraments,  appointed  for  that  purjiose  by- 
our  Lord  himself — "  the  outward  and  visible 
signs  of  the  inward  spiritual  grace."  Thus, 
water  is  the  element  of  baptism,  and  bread 
and  wine  are  the  elements  of  the  Eucharist. 

I.  (a)  It  has  always  been  the  practice  of 
the  Church  to  use  a  form  of  benediction 
upon  the  water  used  at  baptism.  "  The- 
waters,"  says  TertuUian,  "are  made  the 
sacrament  of  sanctification  by  invocation  of" 
God"  {De  Bapt.  c.  4).  St.  Cyprian  and 
many  of  the  Fathers  speak  in  like  manner. 
St.  Augustine,  referring  to  baptism,  asks, 
"  What  is  the  baptism  of  Christ  V  The 
washing  of  water  by  the  Word :  take  away- 
the  water,  it  is  no  baptism  ;  take  away  the 
Word,  it  is  no  baptism." — On  St.  John,, 
Tract  XV.  4  (See  Baptism). 

(/3)  The  elements  for  the  use  of  the 
Eucharist  were  in  early  times  taken  out  of 
the  oblations  of  bread  and  wine  which  were 


ELEMENTS 

offered  by  the  people.  The  bread  used  was 
common  bread,  made  for  ordinary  occasions 
(Ambrose,  de  Sacram.  lib.  iv.  c.  4).  The 
use  of  wafers  and  unleavened  bread  was 
not  known  till  the  eleventh  or  twelfth 
century.  Bona  suggests  with  probability 
that  it  was  because  of  the  people  leaving 
off  making  their  oblations  in  common 
bread,  that  the  clergy  themselves  provided 
the  bread,  and,  from  motives  of  reverence, 
substituted  unleavened  bread  or  wafers  for 
what  had  been  before  used  (^Ser.  Liturg. 
lib.  i.)  (See  Wafer).  The  wine  seems 
always  to  have  been  mixed  with  water  in 
the  early  times.  Justin  Martyr  {Apol.  i. 
c.  65),  Irenajus  (ad  Exr.  lib.  v.  c.  2,  and 
c.  36),  St.  Cyprian  {Ep.  63,  ad  Cxcilium), 
and  many  other  writers,  refer  to  this  custom 
(See  Mixed  Chalice).  But  there  is  no 
express  command  with  regard  to  this  in 
any  ancient  councils  or  canons,  and  divines 
of  all  ages  have  agreed  that  it  is  not  es- 
sential to  the  sacrament. — Bingham,  bk.  xi. 
c.  10 ;  bk.  XV.  c.  2. 

11.  In  the  English  Communion  Office  of 
1549  there  was  no  special  prayer  connected 
with  the  oblation  of  the  elements.  The 
priest  is  directed  in  the  rubric  to  lay  "  the 
bread  upon  the  corporas,  or  else  in  the 
paten,  or  in  some  other  comely  thing  .  .  . 
putting  the  wine  into  the  chalice,  putting 
thereto  a  little  pure  and  clean  water,  and 
setting  both  the  bread  and  wine  upon  the 
altar."  In  1661  the  rubric  stood  thus : 
"  when  there  is  a  communion,  the  priest 
shall  then  place  upon  the  table  so  much 
bread  and  wine  as  he  shall  think  suffi- 
cient;" Then,  that  is,  after  the  offertory, 
and  after  presenting  the  basin  with  the 
alms.  This  rubric  being  added  to  our 
liturgy  at  the  last  review,  at  the  same 
time  with  the  word  "oblations,"  in  the 
prayer  following,  it  is  the  opinion  of  many, 
such  as  Bishop  Patrick,  that  by  that  word 
are  to  be  understood  the  elements  of  bread 
and  wine,  which  the  priest  is  to  offer 
solemnly  to  God  as  an  acknowledgment 
of  His  sovereignty  over  His  creatures, 
and  that  from  henceforth  they  might  be- 
come properly  and  peculiarly  His.  For  in 
all  the  Jewish  sacrifices,  of  which  the  peo- 
ple were  partakers,  the  viands  or  materials 
of  the  feast  were  first  made  God's  by  a 
solemn  oblation,  and  then  afterwards  eaten 
by  the  communicants,  not  as  man's,  but  as 
God's  provisions,  who  by  thus  entertaining 
them  at  His  own  table,  declared  Himself 
reconciled,  and  again  in  covenant  with 
them.  And  therefore  our  blessed  Saviour, 
when  He  instituted  the  new  sacrament  of 
His  own  body  and  blood,  first  gave  thanks 
and  blessed  the  elements ;  that  is,  offered 
them  up  to  God  as  Lord  of  the  creatures, 
as  the  most  ancient  Fathers  expound  that 


ELEVATION 


321 


passage ;  who  for  that  reason,  whenever 
they  celebrated  the  holy  Eucharist,  alwaj's 
offered  the  bread  and  wine  for  the  com- 
munion to  God  upon  the  altar  by  this  or 
some  short  ejaculation :  "  Lord,  we  offer 
thee  thine  own  out  of  what  thou  hast 
bountifully  given  us."  After  which  they 
received  them  into  the  sacred  banquet  of 
the  body  and  blood  of  His  dear  Son. — Bp. 
Patrick  on  the  Ghristian  Sacrifice ;  Water- 
land,  Doct.  of  Eveh.  xii.  532  (See  Ohlations, 
Offertory). 

In  the  ancient  Church  there  was  gene- 
rally a  side  table,  or  prothesis,  near  the 
altar,  upon  which  the  elements  were  laid 
till  the  first  part  of  the  communion  service 
was  over  (See  Credence), 

In  the  coronation  service  of  Queen  Vic- 
toria, after  the  reading  of  the  sentences  in 
the  Offertory,  this  rubric  occurs.  "And 
first  the  Queen  offers  bread  and  wine  for  the 
communion,  which  being  brought  out  ot 
King  Edward's  chapel,  and  delivered,  into 
her  hands,  the  bread  upon  the  paten  by  the 
bishop  who  read  the  Epistle,  and  the  wine 
in  the  chalice  by  the  bishop  that  read  the 
Gospel,  are  by  tha  archbishop  received  from 
the  Queen,  and  reverently  placed  upon  the 
altar,  and  decently  covered  with  a  fair 
linen  cloth,  the  archbishop  first  saying  this 
prayer,"  &c.  (See  Wheatly,  and  Maskell, 
Mon.  Bit.  iii.  127).     [H.] 

ELEVATION.  In  architecture,  a  re- 
presentation of  a  building,  or  of  any  por- 
tion of  it,  as  it  would  appear  if  it  were 
possible  that  the  eye  should  be  exactly 
opposite  every  part  of  it  at  the  same  time. 
Consequently  it  shows  no  depths,  and  is 
by  itself  misleading. 

ELEVATION  OP  THE  HOST.  This 
Romish  ceremony,  condemned  in  our 
twenty-fifth  Article,  is  not,  comparatively 
speaking,  an  ancient  rite.  In  the  hturgy  of 
St.  Chrysostom,  of  St.  Basil,  and  in  the 
Armenian  liturgy,  the  priest  is  directed  to 
elevate  the  holy  bread,  and  exclaim,  "  Holy 
things  for  holy  persons."  But  this  evi- 
dently does  not  imply  the  elevation  for 
"  adoration."  The  Roman  ritualists.  Bona, 
Merati,  Benedict  XIV.,  Le  Brun,  &c., 
acknowledge  that  there  is  no  trace  of  the 
elevation  for  adoration  before  the  eleventh 
or  twelfth  century  in  the  West.  The  Ordo 
Romanus,  Amalarius,  Walafrid  Strabo, 
and  Micrologus,  make  no  mention  of  the 
rite,  though  the  last  of  these  ritiiftlists 
lived  at  the  end  of  the  eleventh  century. 
The  truth  is,  that  no  certain  documents 
refer  to  it  until  the  beginning  of  the 
thirteenth  century,  but  it  may  possibly 
have  existed  in  some  places  in  the  twelfth. 
The  synodical  constitutions  of  Odo  de  SuUi, 
bishop  of  Paris,  about  1200,  appoint  this 
elevation,  and  it  was  probably  then  first 


322 


ELEVATION 


introduced  into  the  diocese  of  Paris.  In- 
nocent III.,  who  wrote  on  the  ceremonies 
of  the  mass  at  the  beginning  of  the  thir- 
teenth century,  does  not  speak  of  it;  but 
in  the  time  of  Honorius  III.  it  had  come 
into  use,  for  he  mentions  it  in  an  epistle 
to  the  Latin  Bishops  of  the  patriarchate  of 
Antioch,  a.d.  1219,  where  he  commands 
.that,  at  the  elevation,  the  people  should 
•reverently  bow.  "Sacerdos  quilibet  fre- 
quenter dooeat  plebem  suam,  ut  cum  in 
celebratione  missanmi  elevatur  hostia  salu- 
•taris,  quilibet  reverenter  inclinet."  This  was 
inserted  in  the  decretals  by  Gregory  IX., 
his  successor,  and  thus  became  the  law  of 
the  West.  It  is  spoken  of  by  Bonaventure, 
Durand,  and  the  (jOuncU  of  Lambeth,  in 
the  latter  part  of  the  same  century;  and 
Cardinal  Guido  is  said  to  have  introduced 
this  rite,  or  some  part  of  it,  at  Cologne, 
about  1265. 

We  know  then,  that,  in  the  thirteenth 
century,  the  host  was  elevated,  and  the 
people  bowed  or  knelt  at  the  same  time. 
But  if  we  are  to  judge  by  the  authorities 
referred  to  by  the  Roman  ritualists  them- 
selves, the  writers  of  that  and  the  follow- 
ing ages  did  not  always  interpret  this  as 
designed  for  the  adoration  of  the  elements, 
or  even  of  Christ  in  the  Eucharist.  Bo- 
naventure (a.d.  1270)  assigns  eight  reasons 
for  the  elevation,  some  of  which  relate  to 
the  duty  or  dispositions  of  the  people  on 
the  occasion ;  but  he  does  not  notice  the 
adoration  of  the  elements.  William,  bishop 
of  Paris,  about  1220,  ordered  a  bell  to  be 
rung  at  the  elevation,  that  the  people 
might  be  excited  to  pray,  but  not  to  worship 
the  host;  "  Prajcipitur  quod  in  celebra- 
tione missarum,  quando  corpus  Christi 
elevatur,  in  ipsa  elevatione,  vel  paulo  ante, 
campana  pulsetur,  siout  aliis  fuit  statutum, 
ut  sic  mentes  fidelium  ad  orationem  ex- 
citentur."  Cardinal  Guido  (a.d.  1265) 
ordained,  that  at  the  elevation  all  the 
people  should  pray  for  pardon.  "Bonam 
illic  consuetudinem  instituit,  ut  ad  eleva- 
tionem  hosticB  omnis  populus  in  ecclesia 
ad  sonltum  note  veniam  peteret,  sicque 
usque  ad  calicis  benedictionem  prostratus 
jaceret."  The  synod  of  Cologne  (a.d. 
1536)  explained  the  people's  duty  at  the 
elevation  to  consist  in  remembering  the 
Lord's  death,  and  (returning  Him  thanks 
with  minds  raised  to  heaven.  "Post  ele- 
vationem  consecrati  corporis  ac  sanguinis 
Domini  .  .  .  tum  videretur  silendum,  et 
ab  onmi  populo  mortis  Dominicaj  comme- 
moratio  habenda,  prostratisque  humi  cor- 
poribus,  animis  in  cffilum  erectis,  gratia3 
agendas  Christo  Eedemptori,  qui  nos  san- 
guine suo  lavit  morteque  redemit." 

On  the  other  hand,  Durand  (1286), 
Lyndwood  (1430),  the  diocesan  synod  of 


EMBER  DAYS 

Augsburg  (1548),  and  Cardinal  Hosius, 
one  of  the  papal  legates  at  the  synod  of 
Trent,  understood  the  prostration  of  the 
people  as  designed  for  the  adoration  of  Christ 
as  corporeally  present  in  the  Eucharist.  Cer- 
tainly this  has  latterly  become  the  common 
opinion,  but  from  what  has  been  said  above 
it  appears  that,  before  the  Reformation,  and 
afterwards,  many  persons  at  the  elevation, 
directed  their  worship  to  God  and  Christ 
simply,  without  any  exclusive  reference  to 
the  presence  of  Christ  in  the  Eucharist. — 
Bona,  Rer.  Liturg.  ii.  c.  13;  Martene,  de 
Bit.  Ecd.  i.  423 ;  Palmer,  Treatise  on  the 
Church,  i.  240;  see  also  Freeman's  Princ. 
Biv.  Servi  Introd.  to  Pt.  ii. ;  Diet.  Christ. 
Antiq.  p.  605. 

The  First  Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI. 
directed  the  consecration  to  be  effected 
without  "any  elevation,  or  showing  the 
sacrament  to  the  people."  And  in  late  years 
elevation,  beyond  the  taking  up  in  the 
hands,  as  ordered  in  the  Prayer  Book,  has, 
in  courts  of  law,  been  declared  illegal. 

EMBER  DATS.  I.  These  are  the 
Wednesday,  Friday,  and  Saturday,  aft«r  the 
first  Sunday  in  Lent,  the  feast  of  Whit- 
sunday, the  14th  of  September,  and  the 
13th  of  December.  They  are  ordered  to  be 
observed  as  days  of  fasting,  in  preparation 
for  the  following  Sundays,  which  are  the 
stated  times  of  ordination  in  the  Church. 
It  is  to  be  remarked,  that  the  Sunday  in 
December  which  begins  the  Ember  week 
is  always  the  third  Sunday  in  Advent.  The 
week  in  which  these  days  fall  is  called 
Ember  week.  But  as  Sunday  begins  the 
week,  the  Ember  collect  is  always  to  be 
read  on  the  Sunday  preceding  the  Ember 
days,  not  on  that  which  follows  them,  as 
is  sometimes  erroneously  done. 

II.  These  days  were  called  "jejunia 
quatuor  temporum,"  i.e.  fasts  of  the  four 
seasons,  whence  is  derived  the  German 
qvatemher,  a  quarter  of  a  year,  or  quarterly 
day.  The  Dutch  word  is  quatuternher ;  the 
Danish  Kvateraber.  The  old  English  name 
of  Ember  week  was  Ymh-ren-vmce.  The 
prefix  "  Ymb,"  which  also  assumed  the 
form  "  emb "  or  "  emhe,"  cognate  with 
German  "um"  and  Latin  "amii,"  or 
Greek  afjKpl  means  about — around.  It  was 
much  used  in  early  English,  but  has  died 
out  of  our  language  (See  Bosworth's  Anglo- 
Saxon  Bid.).  "  Ren "  or."  rene  "  or  "  ryne " 
means  a  course,  and  so  the  Ember  weeks 
{Ymb-ren)  would  seem  to  have  got  the  name 
from  coming  round  periodically.  The  deriva- 
tion of  the  name  from  "  ashes  "  or  "  embers  " 
need  not  be  considered.  In  an  old  English 
edition  of  the  Gospels  this  heading  is  given, 
"Thys  godspel  sceal  to  tbam  ymb-rene 
innan  harefeste  on  Saterndseg;"  i.e.  this 
gospel  shall  be  read  at  the  Ember  in  harvest 


EMBLEM 

on    Saturday. — Thorpe's    Edition    of    Old 
English  Gospels,  St.  Luke  xiii.  6. 

IIL  Attempts  have  been  made  to  prove 
that  these  days  for  ordination  were  ap- 
pointed by  the  Apostles  themselves ;  but  it 
appears  probable  that  Gelasius  was  the  first 
who  limited  the  seasons  of  general  ordination 
to  certain  times  of  the  year.  According  to 
Micrologus,  "Gelasius  papa  constituit  ut 
ordinationes  presbyterorum  et  diaconorum 
non  nisi  certis  temporibus  fiant "  (cap.  24, 
p.  448,  edit.  Hittorp).  "  There  is  no  doubt, 
however,"  says  Maskell,  "that  the  appropri- 
ation of  certain  times  of  the  years  to  the 
solemnities  of  general  ordinations,  is  of  an 
antiquity  reaching  if  not  to  Apostolical,  at 
least  to  almost  primitive  times"  (For  an 
account  of  the  ancient  "  Ember  fast,"  see 
■Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  p.  607).  In  the  Peni- 
tential of  Archbishop  Egbert,  these  words 
occur:  " Hi  sunt  legitimi quatuor  temponma 
dies,  qui  legitime  observari  debent:  id  est, 
kal.  Martii,  prima  hebdomada;  et  kal. 
Junii  secunda  heb*;  et  kal.  Septembr. 
tertiaheb*;  et  kal.  Decembr.  heb\  proxima 
ante  natale  Christi "  (Thorpe,  Ancient 
Jmws,  vol.  ii.  p.  235).  In  the  excerpts  of 
Egbert  also,  reference  is  made  to  the  ordina- 
tion of  priests  and  deacons  "in  qxiatuor 
temporum  sabbatis."  The  reasons  why  the 
ordinations  are  fixed  to  set  times  have  been 
thus  stated :  "  (1)  That  as  all  men's  souls  are 
concerned  in  the  ordaining  a  fit  clergy,  so 
all  may  join  in  fasting  and  prayer  for  a 
blessing  oti  it;  (2)  that  both  bishops  and 
candidates,  knowing  the  time,  may  prepare 
themselves  for  this  great  work;  (3)  that 
the  people,  knowing  the  time,  may,  if  they 
please,  be  present,  either  to  approve  the 
choice  made  by  the  bishop,  or  to  object 
against  those  they  know  to  be  unworthy." — 
Wheatly,  Com.  Prayer,  c.  iv.  Append. ;  Mas- 
kell, Mon.  Bit.  Ang.  Ecd.  i.,  cxxxv. ;  Evan 
Daniel,  P.  B. ;  Thorpe,  Ancient  Laws ;  Diet. 
Christ.  Antiq. 

EMBLEM.  A  visible,  and  usually  an  orna- 
mental, symbol  of  some  spiritual  thing ;  of 
some  great  truth  concerning  the  object  of  a 
Ohristian's  worship,  of  some  object  of  his  faith 
and  hope,  or  of  some  mystery  or  privilege. 

The  use  of  emblems,  under  which  the 
truths  of  Christianity  were  veiled  from  the 
heathen,  while  they  were  presented  vividly 
to  the  minds  of  the  faithful,  is  probably  as 
old  as  Christianity  itself ;  and  the  fancy  of 
pious  persons  has  continued  it  to  the  present 
•day ;  many  particular  emblems  having  been 
so  generally  and  almost  universally  used,  as 
to  have  been  interwoven  almost  with  the 
very  external  habit  of  the  Church  itself. 
Among  the  most  apt  and  venerable  may  be 
mentioned,  the  trine  compass  (as  it  is  called 
by  Chaucer), 

"That  of  trine  compass  Lord  and  gide  is." 


EMBOLISMUS 


323 


or  a  circle  inscribed  within  an  equilateral 
triangle,  denoting  the  coequality  and  co- 
eternity  of  the  three  Divine  Persons  in  the 
ever-blessed  and  undivided  Trinity;  the 
hand  extended  from  the  clouds  in  the  atti- 
tude of  benediction,  for  the  first  Person; 
the  Lamb  triumphant ;  the  fish  (see  Piscis) ; 
the  pelican  wounding  her  own  breast  to 
feed  her  young ;  the  Good  Shepherd  and 
others,  for  the  second  Person ;  the  dove,  for 
the  third  Person  in  the  Blessed  Trinity; 
the  chalice  receiving  the  blood  of  the 
wounded  Lamb,  for  the  holy  Eucharist ; 
the  phosnix  rising  from  the  flames,  for  the 
resurrection;  the  cross,  for  the  Christian's  life 
of  conflict ;  the  crown,  for  his  hope  of  glory. 

It  is  of  the  essence  of  a  proper  emblem 
that  it  be  not,  nor  pretend  to  be,  a  simple 
representation.  It  then  loses  its  allusive 
character,  and  becomes  a  mere  picture  of 
the  thing  itself.  In  theology  there  is  another 
reason  why  this  should  be  avoided;  for 
when  we  attempt  a  representation  of  any 
object  of  Christian  worship,  we  too  nearly 
fall  into  idolatry.  This  was  Tertullian's 
objection  to  images  and  representations  of 
all  kinds  (Lc  Idol.  iii.).  But  he  was  writing 
against  Paganism,  and  would  except  the 
Scriptural  emblems.  Clement  of  Alexandria 
also  has  mgntioned  some  emblems  which  we 
ought  to  avoid,  and  others  which  we  may 
employ;  of  which  latter  we  may  name  a 
dove,  a  fish,  a  ship  borne  along  by  a  full 
breeze,  and  an  anchor  {Pxdag.  iii.  11). 

Emblems  in  architecture  are  frequent,  as 
the  building  in  the  form  of  a  cross;  the 
"  arch  of  triumph  "  between  the  central  nave 
and  the  sanctuary;  the  altar  at  the  east,  &c. 
The  emblem  of  a  ship  is  often  used,  as  by 
the  author  of  the  Apostolical  "Constitutions." 
"  Let  the  building  be  long,  with  its  head  to 
the  east,  with  its  vestries  on  both  sides  at 
the  east  end,  so  it  will  be  like  a  ship.  .  .  . 
The  deacons  are  like  the  mariners  and 
managers  of  the  ship  "  (Bk.  ii.  57). 

EMBOLISMUS  (e>0oXi(r/tdr,  from  e^- 
fioKKfiv,  to  insert).  The  name  given  to  a 
prayer  against  evil  and  the  evil  one,  inserted 
between  the  last  sentence  and  the  doxology 
in  the  Lord's  Prayer.  It  was  said  by  the 
priest  alone,  generally  in  an  undertone,  and 
then  the|doxology  was  said  aloud.  In  the 
Liturgy  of  St.  James,  the  Embolismus  comes 
in  thus : — After  the  first  part  of  the  Lord's 
Prayer  has  been  said  by  the  people,  the 
priest  says  secretly,  "  and  lead  us  not  into 
temptation,  Lord  God  of  Hosts,  who  knowest 
our  infirmities,  but  deliver  us  from  the  evil 
one  and  his  works,  and  all  his  insults  and 
devices,  for  thy  holy  name's  sake,  by  which 
our  humility  is  called  ;  {Aloud)  For  thine 
is  the  kingdom,"  &c.  In  the  Mozarabic 
Liturgy,  the  EmboHsmus  is  a  great  deal 
longer.     It  does  not  appear  in  the  Liturgies 

Y  2 


32i 


EMMANUEL 


of  St.  Chrysostom  and  St.  Basil.  It  has 
been  suggested  by  some  that  the  doxology 
at  the  end  of  the  Lord's  Prayer  was  derived 
from  the  Embolismus ;  hut  it  must  be  re- 
membered that  the  doxology  is  omitted  in 
only  eight  or  nine  out  of  800  Greek  MSS. ; 
that  it  exists  in  the  Alexandrian  Codex 
(though  absent  from  N,  B  and  D),  and  is 
quoted  by  St.  Chrysostom  and  other  Fathers 
(See  Doxology;  Scrivener's  Supplement  to 
Authm-ised  Version;  Neale's  Introd.  Hist. 
Eastern  Church,  513-626  ;  Blunt's  Diet,  of 
Doctrinal  Theol. ;  Diet.  Christ.  Antiq). 

EMMANUBL,orIMMANUEL(bN-lJfii5>j. 
A  Hebrew  word,  which  signifies  "  Grod  with 
us."  Isaiah  (vii.  14),  in  that  celebrated 
prophecy,  in  which  he  foretells  to  Ahaz  the 
birth  of  the  Messiah  from  a  virgin,  says, 
"  This  chUd  shall  be  called  Emmanuel,  God 
with  us."  He  repeats  this  while  speaking  of 
the  enemy's  army,  which,  like  a  torrent, 
was  to  overflow  Judea :  "  The  stretching  of 
his  wings  shall  fill  the  breadth  of.  thy  land, 
0  Emmanuel."  St.  Matthew  (i.  23)  states 
that  this  prophecy  was  accomplished  in  the 
birth  of  Christ,  bom  of  the  Virgin  Mary,  in 
whom  the  two  natures,  Divine  and  human, 
were  united ;  so  that  He  was  really  Emma- 
nuel, or  "  God  with  us." 

ENC^aiNIA  (ey/caiVia).  Anniversary 
festivals  kept  in  memory  of  the  dedication 
of  churches.  In  the  peaceable  reign  of 
Constantine,  following  the  disturbed  times 
of  persecution,  it  was  a  desirable  sight,  as 
Eusebius  says,  to  behold  how  the  consecra- 
tions of  the  new-built  churches,  and  the 
feasts  of  the  dedications,  were  solemnised  in 
every  city  (Eusb.  lib.  x.  c.  5).  An  anni- 
versary festival,  which  lasted  for  eight  days, 
at  which  multitudes  flocked  together,  and 
frequent  services  were  held,  was  observed  in 
the  church  at  Jerusalem,  built  to  the  honour 
of  our  Saviour  (Soz.  lib.  ii.  c.  26),  and  from 
this  the  custom  spread  to  other  churches. 
Gregory  Nazianzen  speaks  of  it  as  an  old 
usage :  "  iynalvia  TijiairBai  jraXaios  vofios  Koi 
KoK&s  tx"""  (■^''^  Novam  Dominicam 
Orat.  xliii.),  and  Gregory  the  Great  recom- 
mended such  an  observance  to  Augustine 
and  Mellitus  for  England  (Bede,  i.  c.  30 ;  see 
Dedication).  Cities  were  also  sometimes 
solemlily  dedicated  to  Christ  and  the  saints, 
and  the  "  Encaenia  "  celebrated :  as  especially 
In  the  case  of  Constantinople  (Ducange, 
Constant.  Christ,  lib.  i.  c.  3).  In  later  times 
ceremonies  renewed  at  certain  periods,  as  at 
Oxford  and  Cambridge,  at  the  celebration  of 
founders  and  benefactors,  are  called  Encaenia. 

ENCRATITES,  or  CONTINENTS.  A 
name  given  to  a  sect  in  the  second  century, 
because  they  condemned  marriage,  forbade 
the  eating  of  flesh  or  drinking  of  wine,  and 
rejected  with  a  sort  of  horror  all  the  com- 


ENCJHIEIDIGN 

forts  and  conveniences  of  life.  Tatian,  an 
Assyrian,  and  a  disciple  of  Justin  Martyr, 
was  the  leader  of  this  sect.  He  was  greatly 
distinguished  for  his  genius  and  learning, 
and  the  excessive  austerity  of  his  life  and 
manners.  He  regarded  matter  as  the 
fountain  of  all  evil,  and  therefore  recom- 
mended in  a  peculiar  manner  the  mortifi- 
cation of  the  body.  He  distinguished  the 
Creator  of  the  world  from  the  Supreme 
Being,  denied  the  reality  of  Christ's  body, 
and  blended  the  Christian  religion  with 
several  corrupt  tenets  of  the  Oriental  philo- 
sophy. Epiphanius  says  that  in  his  time 
these  heretics  abounded  in  Asia  Minor. — 
User,  xlvii. ;  Mosheim,  i.  196. 

ENEBGUMENS,  DEMONIACS,  from. 
ivepyovjiivoi,  which  in  the  largest  sense 
denotes  persons  under  the  motion  or  oper- 
ation of  any  spirit  whatever,  good  or  bad; 
but  is  used  by  ecclesiastical  writers  in  a 
restricted  sense,  to  denote  persons  whose 
bodies  are  possessed  by  an  evil  spirit. 
Mention  is  often  made  in  the  primitive 
Church  of  persons  possessed  of  an  evil  spirit. 
The  regulations  of  the  Church  bestowed 
upon  them  special  care.  They  constituted 
a  distinct  class  of  Christians,  bearing  some 
relation  both  to  the  catechumens  and  the 
faithful;  but  differing  from  both  in  this, 
that  they  were  under  the  special  oversight 
and  direction  of  exorcists,  while  they  took 
part  in  some  of  the  religious  exercises  of 
both  classes.  The  description  given  by 
Cyprian  {de  Idol.  Vanit.),  and  by  Chrysostom 
{Ham.  iv.  de  incomprehens.  Not.  Dei)  of 
the  energumens,  or  demoniacs,  would  seem  to 
show  that  they  were  persons  suffering  imder 
different  stages  of  insanity  or  epilepsy;  or 
some  morbid  state  of  mind.  Under  the  wise 
regulations  of  the  Church,  at  all  events,  the 
supposed  sudden  expulsions  of  the  demon, 
mentioned  by  St.  Cyprian,  became  rare ;  or 
rather  we  may  suppose  that  the  excitement 
of  the  mind  was  remedied  by  judicious 
treatment. 

Catechumens  who,  during  their  proba- 
tionary exercises,  became  demoniacs,  were 
never  baptised  until  thoroughly  healed, 
except  in  case  of  extreme  sickness.  Be- 
lievers who  became  demoniacs,  in  the  worst 
stage  of  their  disease,  like  the  weeping 
penitents,  were  not  permitted  to  enter  the 
church ;  hut  were  retained  under  close 
inspection  in  the  outer  porch.  Whea 
partially  recovered  they  were  permitted, 
with  the  audientes,  to  join  in  public  worship, 
but  they  were  not  permitted  to  partake  of 
the  Eucharist  until  wholly  restored,  except 
in  the  immediate  prospect  of  death.  In 
egenral,  the  energumens  were  subject  to  the 
same  rules  as  the  penitents. — Bingham,  bk» 
iii.  c.  4. 

ENCHIRIDION.     Another  title  of  the 


ENDOWMENT 

Horce.  The  contents  and  arrangement  are 
exactly  similar.  It  may  have  been  used  in 
foreign  churches  to  signify  the  Manual,  but 
there  is  no  example  of  it  in  the  English 
Manuals.  Mr.  Maskell  knows  but  two 
editions  of  the  Horse  entitled  Enchiridion  of 
the  dates  1528  and  1530. — Mon.  Hit.  JSccles. 
Ang.  i.  cxcv.  (See  Horie). 

ENDOWMENT  AND  ESTABLISH- 
MENT. The  property  of  the  Church  of 
England  may  be  roughly  classed  under  the 
following  heads.  (1)  Churches  and  Cathe- 
drals. (2)  Tithes,  Glebes„Easter  Offerings, 
and  Residences.  (3)  Property  under  the 
administration  of  Queen  Aime's  Bounty  and 
the  Ecclesiastical  Commission  respectively. 
No  statistics  exist  from  which  it  would  be 
possible  to  frame  a  reliable  money  valuation 
of  the  whole  mass  of  Church  property  or  of 
its  different  parts.  The  anomalous  charac- 
ter of  some  kinds  make  an  accurate  assess- 
ment peculiarly  difficult.  Nevertheless 
several  attempts  have  been  made  in  recent 
years,  the  results  of  which  ought  not  perhaps 
to  be  ignored. 

In  1877  Mr.  Frederick  Martin,  at  the 
instance  of  the  Liberation  Society,  made  an 
estimate  of  the  annual  value  of  Church 
property  exclusive  of  the  cathedrals  and 
churches,  and  of  the  surplus  revenue  of  the 
Ecclesiastical  Commission.  He  fixed  it  at 
£5,383,560. 

In  1878  Mr.  Arthur  Arnold,  in  an  article 
on  "The  Business  Aspects  of  Disestablish- 
ment," which  appeared  in  the  Nineteenth 
Century  of  April  in  that  year,  worked  out  the 
same  problem,  and  found  the  income  (ex- 
clusive of  the  value  of  cathedrals  and 
churches)  to  be  £7,502,602.  The  Church 
Defence  Institution,  on  what  grounds  is  not 
stated,  assess  the  Church's  revenue  (subject 
to  the  same  deduction)  at  £4,200,000. 

Our  next  duty  is  to  ascertain  the  sources 
of  Church  property.  The  first  churches 
erected  in  England  after  the  Augustinian 
Mission  (a.d.  597 — it  is  useless  for  the 
present  purpose  to  go  further  back)  were 
built  by  the  bishops,  and  were  either  cathe- 
drals or  served  as  chapels  of  ease  to  the 
cathedrals  or  central  churches.  How  far 
the  expenses  were  borne  by  local  contribu- 
tions, or  were  defrayed  out  of  diocesan  funds 
under  the  bishops'  control,  it  is  impossible 
at  this  distance  of  time  to  determine.  In 
either  case,  the  source  was  the  same,  for  the 
bishops  had  nothing  but  what  the  people, 
small  and  great,  chose  to  give  them.  Both 
churches  and  cathedrals  were  built  on  land, 
and  with  materials  freely  offered  for  the 
purpose.  As  the  ecclesiastical  organization 
of  the  kingdom  became  more  complete,  and 
parish  churches  began  to  spring  up  in  every 
township,  the  duty  of  providing  buildings 
passed  out  of  the  hands  of  the  bishops  and 


ENDOWMENT 


325 


devolved  on  the  lords  or  landowners.  Each 
landowner  erected  the  church  on  his  own 
estate,  and  the  bishop  consecrated  it.  The 
agreement  between  them  was  this, — the 
lay-landowner,  who  thus  became  patron, 
was  to  nominate  the  priest  to  serve  the 
church,  and  was  bound  to  provide  for  his 
maintenance ;  on  the  other  hand,  the  bishop 
required  to  be  satisfied  of  the  fitness  of  the 
patron's  nominee,  and  of  the  adequacy  of 
the  provision  made  for  his  support  before 
he  granted  consecration.  1'he  endow- 
ment consisted  chiefly  of  a  house  and  a  few 
strips  of  land  in  the  common  fields,  set  apart 
for  the  priest's  use  by  the  lord.  It  will  be 
remembered  that  in  Saxon  times  and  for 
centuries  afterwards  all  the  arable  land  of 
each  township  was  collected  in  one  great 
field,  and  all  the  meadow  in  another.  These 
common  fields,  as  they  were  called,  were 
divided  into  strips  and  appropriated  to  the 
lord  and  his  tenants,  according  to  their 
different  needs  and  positions.  In  making 
this  apportionment  it  ■was  usual  to  set  apart 
a  certain  number  of  strips,  sometimes  more, 
sometimes  less,  for  the  priest.  Domesday 
Book,  which  gives  but  a  very  incomplete 
account  of  churches  (no  return  of  them 
having  been  ordered),  contains  ample  re- 
ferences to  the  provision  made  for  the 
priest's  support  in  the  common  fields.  This 
is  the  origin  of  the  rectory  and  glebe  or 
manse  as  the  two  together  were  called  (see 
Olebe).  Thus,  like  the  fabric  of  the  church, 
the  house  and  land  of  the  clergyman  may 
be  traced  to  the  voluntary  offerings  of 
individual  landlords.  No  law  exists,  or 
ever  has  existed,  by  which  the  lord  of  a 
manor  was  compelled  to  build  or  compelled 
to  endow  a  church  on  his  estate.  He  acted, 
if  at  all,  of  his  own  accord,  to  promote  the 
good  of  himself  and  his  tenants,  and  probably 
also  to  increase  the  importance  of  his 
property. 

For  the  history  and  development  of  the 
custom  of  paying  tithe  and  other  offerings, 
see  Tithe. 

For  an  account  of  Queen  Anne's  Bounty 
and  its  property,  see  Annates. 

The  Ecclesiastical  Commission  was 
founded  in  the  year  1836.  There  was  at 
that  time  a  redistribution  of  the  endow- 
ments of  the  Church.  Sinecures  were 
abolished.  Some  of  the  bishops'  incomes 
were  reduced,  and  the  funds  thus  set  free 
were,  and  are,  appropriated  to  building  new 
churches,  endowing  new  livings,  and  other- 
wise helping  the  Church's  work.  It  has 
been  said  above  that  the  parish  churches  of 
England  were  in  ancient  times  built  by  the 
landowners.  That  state  of  things  continued 
until  the  present  century,  with  exceptions  too 
trifling  to  be  mentioned.  But  for  the  last 
sixty  years  the  Church  Building  Acts  have 


S26 


ENDOWMENT 


been  in  operation.'  Between  1809  and  1820 
eleven  grants  of  £100,000  eacli  in  augmen- 
tation of  livings  were  made  by  Parliament. 
In  1818  Parliament  voted  £1,000,000  of 
public  money  for  building  churches.  This 
was  supplemented  in  1825  by  a  further  grant 
of  £500,000.  Prior  to  this,  in  Queen  Anne's 
reign,  a  BiU  had  been  passed  for  building  fifty 
new  churches  in  London  and  Westminster, 
and  a  duty  on  coal,  which  had  been  pre- 
viously applied  towards  rebuilding  St.  Paul's 
Cathedral  after  the  Great  Pire,  was  trans- 
ferred to  answer  this  purpose.  With  these 
exceptions,  it  is  believed  that  no  State  grant 
for  building  or  endowing  churches  has  ever 
been  made. 

The  churches  built  under  the  Church 
Building  Acts  are  very  numerous.  They 
have  all  been  paid  for  out  of  one  of  three 
sources : — 

(1)  Private  subscriptions ; 

(2)  Ecclesiastical  Commission ; 

(3)  A  rate  with  the  consent  of  an  actual 
majority  of  owners  in  the  parish. 

The  different  sources  of  Chiurch  Endow- 
ments may  be  summed  up  as  follows : — 

Cathedrals,  churches,  glebes  and  parson- 
ages have  been  provided  by  the  separate 
voluntary  gifts  of  individuals  either  directly, 
or,  as  in  the  last  half  centuiy,  indirectly 
out  of  funds  made  available  by  a  readjust- 
ment of  old  endo^vments,  the  relics  of  the 
pious  generosity  of  former  times. 

Tithes  and  Easter  offerings  are  the  out- 
come of  a  custom  which  began  in  voluntaiy 
gifts,  was  promoted  by  (1)  religioxis  admoni- 
tion, (2)  Church  law,  and  (3)  Royal 
authority,  imtil  it  gradually,  in  the  case  of 
tithes,  became  \miversal,  and  was  accepted 
as  part  of  the  common  law,  controlled  and 
ratified  by  statute. 

The  property  owned  by  Queen  Anne's 
Bounty  and  the  Ecclesiastical  Commission 
belonged  to  the  Church  before  it  was  vested 
in  those  bodies,  and  represents  no  new  or 
separate  source  of  endowTnent. 

The  pretence  that  the  State  has  endowed 
the  Church  is  thus  seen  to  be  an  idle,  and 
ignorant  fiction. 

To  complete  our  view  of  Endowment,  it 
only  remains  to  explain  how  Church 
property  is  held.  In  one  sense  the  Church 
of  England  has  no  property.  The  church, 
the  glebe,  and  the  tithes  of  eveiy  parish  are 
vested  in  its  rector.  The  bishops  are  paid 
salaries  out  of  the  funds  of  the  Ecclesiastical 
Commission;  the  cathedrals  and  their  en- 
dowments are  vested  in  the  Deans  and 
Chapters.  Queen  Anne's  Bounty  and  the 
Ecclesiastical  Commission  are  corporations, 
and  each  holds  its  own  property.  But 
although  Church  property,  as  to  its  legal 
ownership,  is  greatly  divided,  nevertheless 
it  is  aU  held  for  common  purposes,  and  is 


ENDOWMENT 

bound  together  into  one  aggregate  whole  by 
numberless  Acts  of  Parliament,  liector, 
bishop,  dean,  and  chapter.  Queen  Anne's 
Bounty  and  Ecclesiastical  Commission,  one 
and  all,  are  strictly  trustees  for  the  Church 
of  England,  for  the  benefit  of  which  they  are 
legally  and  morally  bound  to  use  the  pro- 
perty vested  in  them  respectively. 

Establishment  is  a  word  which  has,  in 
connexion  with  the  Church,  an  acquired  or 
rather  a  developed  meaning,  which  can  only 
be  understood  by  reference  to  the  political 
history  of  the  Church  of  England.  That 
history  may  be  divided  into  three  epochs. 

I.  Prom  the  conversion  of  England  to  the 
Eeformation,  or  the  Era  of  Unity,  when 
there  was  but  one  Church  Icnown.  The 
Churches  of  Eome  and  England  were  one 
in  commimion,  and  although  they  were 
distinct  in  external  organization,  there  was 
no  such  thing  as  membership  of  the  one  body 
to  the  exclusion  of  the  other.  The  idea  of 
Dissent  did  not  exist.  To  be  a  Christian 
and  to  belong  to  the  Church  were  identical 
expressions.  As  there  was  but  one  Church, 
not  only  in  fact  but  also  in  the  minds  and 
thoughts  of  men,  there  was  no  need  of  any 
descriptive  adjective.  The  word  "estab- 
lished" was  not  used  in  connexion  with 
the  Chm-ch.  It  would  have  been  as  un^ 
meaning  as  to  speak  of  the  established  king 
or  the  established  Aula  JRegis. 

II.  Prom  the  Reformation  to  the  Revo- 
lution, or  the  Era  of  Uniformity.  Prom  the 
time  when  Henry  VIII.  threw  off  the  Papal 
yoke  and  the  Pope  excommunicated  Henry, 
the  idea  of  separate  religious  bodies  gaiued 
possession  of  men's  minds.  There  were 
soon  many  other  divisions  besides  that 
caused  by  the  great  breach  with  Rome.  In, 
1547  the  writer  of  the  Eomily  on  Good 
Works  could  say,  "  Sects  and  feigned 
religions  were  not  the  forty  part  so  many 
among  the  Jews  .  .  .  than  of  late  days 
they  have  been  among  us."  But  alongside 
with  the  idea  of  religious  division  was  also 
the  idea  that  division  ought  not  to  be  tole- 
rated. Prom  1534  to  1688  Churchmen, 
Roman  Catholics,  Presbyterians,  and  Inde- 
pendents in  turn,  as  they  rose  to  the  top 
tried  to  hold  down  and  suppress  their  rivals. 
During  far  the  greater  part  of  this  period 
the  Reformed  Church  was  predominant,  and 
no  other  form  of  religion  was  tolerated.  Men 
were  coerced  into  uniformity  as  far  ag 
possible.  Such  was  the  principle  of  govern- 
ment imiversally  accepted.  It  was  during 
this  time  thjit  the  word  "  established  "  came 
into  use.  First,  as  to  establishing  the 
Prayer  Book  (5  &  6  Edw.  VI.  ch.  1),  and 
the  Articles  (13  Eliz.  ch.  12),  and  secondly, 
"  the  Church  of  England  by  law  established  " 
(Canons  of  1603).  Until  the  Reformation 
no  liturgy  had  been  enforced  by  law.    There 


ENDOWMENT 

were  various  "  Uses."  Therefore,  when  it 
was  intended  to  insist  on  the  adoption  of 
one  liturgy  throughout  England,  and  to  do 
so  by  Act  of  Parliament,  "establishing" 
was  a  natural  and  accurate  term  to  be  em- 
ployed. Tudor  Acts  usually  begin,  "Let 
it  be  established  and  enacted "  that,  &c. 
Gradually,  as  the  word  in  this  context  got 
more  famUiar,  and  the  breach  with  Bome 
wider  and  more  fixed,  men  began  to  talk  of 
the  Church  itself  as  established  by  law,  to 
denote,  not  any  act  or  process  by  which  the 
condition  of  estabhshmcnt  was  produced, 
but  the  condition  itself.  The  Church  is, 
from  the  first  employment  of  the  word,  de- 
scribed as  now  estabUshed,  that  is,  as  already 
in  the  condition  of  establishment.  The 
meaning  of  the  expression  "  established  by 
law  "  during  this  period  is  that  the  Church, 
with  its  doctrine  and  its  discipline,  was 
established  iy  compulsion  of  Taw  as  the 
only  and  national  Church,  no  other  religious 
tody  being  tolerated.  Two  ideas  are  in- 
volved in  the  words  "  established  by  law." 
First,  as  we  have  said,  that  of  compulsion, 
and  secondly,  that  of  contrast  with  other 
reUgious  bodies.  The  enforcement  of  con- 
formity by  law  was  nothing  new.  Even 
before  the  Lollardy  Acts,  the  Church 
Courts  would  at  any  time  have  punished 
heresy,  and  the  State  would  have  given  its 
aid.  But  until  the  Church  of  England  had 
rivals,  and  had,  as  it  were,  to  struggle  to 
keep  its  position,  it  did  not  enter  into  men's 
minds  to  lay  stress  upon  the  fact  that  the 
Church  was  established  by  law  (see  Canon 
10).  Until  then  this  particular  feature  of 
its  constitution  was  not  prominent.  The 
Church's  claims  were  taken  for  granted. 
No  one  mentioned  them,  because  no  one 
questioned  them. 

III.  From  the  Revolution  to  the  present 
time,  or  the  Era  of  Toleration.  On  the 
accession  of  William  and  Mary  the  Tolera- 
tion Act  "for  exempting  their  Majesties' 
Protestant  subjects  dissenting  from  the 
Church  of  England  from  the  penalties  of 
certain  laws"  was  passed.  It  is  needless 
to  trace  the  development  of  the  policy  thus 
inaugurated.  Prom  that  time  there  has 
been  no  establishment  of  the  Church  of 
England  by  compulsion  of  law.  The  old 
meaning  had  obviously  gone  when  the 
Toleration  Act  was  passed,  yet  the  word 
itself  has  come  into  more  constant  use  than 
ever.  "ITie  Protestant  Reformed  religion 
established  by  law  "  (Coronation  Oath,  1  W. 
&  M.  ch.  6) ;  "  such  an  establishment "  (Bill 
of  Rights,  1  W.  &  M.  sess.  2,  ch.  2) ;  Church 
of  England  as  by  law  established  (Act  of 
Settlement,  12  &  13  W.  III.  ch.  2 ;  Treaty 
of  Union  between  Scotland  and  England,  6 
Anne,  ch.  8,  and  ch.  11 ;  Act  of  Union  with 
Ireland,  39  &  40  Geo.  IIL  ch.  67).    The 


ENOCH 


327 


expression  is  retained  in  ecclesiastical  legisla- 
tion to  this  day.  It  cannot  any  longer  be 
understood  in  the  sense  of  legal  compulsion. 
It  must  be  taken  to  denote  special  recogni- 
tion. This  is  then  the  developed  meaning 
which  the  word  has  at  the  present  time.  It 
will  be  noticed  that  in  this  sense  establish- 
ment does  not  point  specially  or  exclusively 
to  the  Church  of  England,  but  is  rather  a 
generic  title  under  which  there  may  be 
many  different  species.  And  so  it  is.  The 
Scotch,  Spanish,  Gennan,  and  Itahan 
Chxurches  have  all,  at  one  time  or  another, 
been  established,  yet  the  variations  and  dif- 
ferences have  been  very  great  indeed.  The 
only  one  feature  which  has  been  the  same  in 
all  has  been  the  fact  of  special  recogniliuii, 
by  the  State.  Again,  establishment  may  be 
produced  by  definite  act  (as  in  Scotland  by 
statute,  or,  as  in  several  of  the  continental 
States,  by  concordat).  On  the  other  hand. 
Establishment  may  arise,  as  in  England,  out, 
of  the  mutual  relations  of  Church  and  State 
growing  up  side  by  side  through  long  cen- 
turies. The  two  have  become  entwined 
together  in  the  course  of  ages,  but  it  is  impos- 
sible to  fix  onany  particular  year  or  event,  and, 
to  say  that  there  and  then  the  Church  became 
established.  All  that  is  practicable  is  to  take 
any  particular  epoch,  either  past  or  present, 
and  to  endeavour  to  ascertain  in  what  the 
special  recognition  of  the  Church  by  the 
State  at  that  time  consists ;  in  other  words, 
to  lay  down  the  principal  relations  between 
Church  and  State,  the  resultant  of  which 
makes  establishment.  These  relations  have 
undergone  considerable  variation  in  the  last 
200  years.  Some  items  of  establishment 
(e.g.  church  rates)  have  vanished,  and  others 
have  been  altered,  yet  the  condition  of 
special  recognition  remains;  just  as  you 
may  change  component  forces  without  in- 
terfering with  the  general  direction  of  their 
resultant.  For  the  leading  features  of 
establishment  at  the  present  time,  see 
Brewer's  Endowment  and  Establishment, 
3rd  ed.  p.  291,  &c.     [L.  T.  D.] 

ENGLAND  (See  Church  of  England). 

ENOCH,  THE  BOOK  OF.  An  apocry- 
phal book,  of  which  there  remain  but  a  few 
fragments.  It  is  quoted  by  St.  Jude  (14-, 
15),  and  was  apparently  well  known  in  the 
second  and  third  centuries.  Justin,  Iren^us, 
Tertullian,  Cyprian,  Clement  of  Alexandria 
and  others  refer  to  it,  but  it  was  never 
included  in  the  Canon  of  Scripture.  St. 
Augustine  says  that  Enoch  wrote  some- 
thing divine  because  he  is  cited  by  St. 
Jude ;  but  he  adds,  it  was  not  without 
reason  that  this  book  was  not  inserted 
in  the  Canon,  which  was  preserved  in  the 
temple  of  Jerusalem,  and  committed  to  the 
care  of  the  sacrificators.  St.  Augustine  suf- 
ficiently insinuates  that  the  authority  of 


S28 


ENTHEONIZATION 


this  Iwok  is  doubtful,  and  that  it  cannot  be 
pioved  that  it  was  really  written  by  Enoch. 
Indeed  the  account  it  gives  of  giants 
engendered  by  angels,  and  not  by  men,  has 
manifestly  the  air  of  a  fable ;  and  the  most 
judicious  critics  believe  it  ought  not  to  be 
ascribed  to  Enoch. — De  Ilahitu  Mulier.  c. 
iii. ;  De  Civit.  Dei,  lib.  xv.  c.  23. 

Tbis  apocryphal  book  lay  a  long  time 
buried  in  darkness  ;  till  Joseph  Scaliger, 
circ.  1600,  recovered  a  part  of  it.  That 
author  gives  us  some  considerable  fragments 
of  it,  in  his  notes  on  the  chronicle  of 
Eusebius ;  various  suggestions  have  been 
made  as  to  the  authorship  of  this  book 
(See  Article  by  Canon  Westcott  in  Diction- 
ary of  the  Bible,  i.  556). 

ENTHRONIZATION  (See  Bishop). 
The  placing  of  a  bishop  in  his  stall  or 
throne  in  his  cathedral. 

Several  forms  relating  to  the  enthroniza- 
tion  of  a  bishop  in  the  thirteenth  century 
are  extant :  as  also  the  summons  to  certain 
abbots  by  Archbishop  Winchelsea  to  attend 
the  solemnityin  his  own  instance. — Wilkius, 
Cone.  torn.  ii.  pp.  196,  214  ;  Maskell,  ii. 
cxliv. 

EPACT.  The  age  of  the  moon  at  the  be- 
ginning of  the  solar  year ;  i.e.  of  that  tabu- 
lar or  calculated  moon  which  is  assumed 
throughout  the  Calendar  (see  E'asier)  whether 
it  be  the  exact  astronomical  one  or  not. 
That  age  is  eleven  days  at  the  end  of  any 
average  year  (of  365i  days)  when  the  new 
moon  was  on  January  1,  a  lunar  being  354^ 
days. 

As  a  lunation  is  29  J  days,  there  may 
evidently  be  29  days  of  epact  in  sufficient 
time ;  but  there  are  only  19  in  any  given 
period  by  the  rules  of  the  Calendar,  until 
they  are  shifted  at  the  end  of  most  centuries ; 
for  the  same  reason  that  there  are  only  19 
Golden  Numbers  or  possible  days  of  equi- 
noctial full  moon  in  the  Calendar  for  each 
century :  viz.,  that  the  real  full  moons 
recur  at  the  same  days  and  hours  every  19 
average  years  very  nearly,  the  error  being 
only  that  which  the  Gregorian  rules,  made 
by  Clavius  the  Jesuit  and  adopted  here  by 
Act  of  Parliament  in  1752,  were  designed  to 
correct  by  the  shifts  at  the  end  of  most 
centuries,  though  not  perfectly.  Certain 
epacts  correspond  to  certain  Golden  Num- 
bers ;  but  the  epacts  are  of  no  real  use  in 
the  calculations  for  Easter  as  the  Golden 
Numbers  are,  which  indicate  the  days  of 
the  Paschal  or  equinoctial  full  moon,  the 
Sunday  after  which  is  Easter.  See  Kees, 
Cydopxdia  on  the  Epact,  and  Sir  E. 
Beckett's  Astronomy  on  the  Calendar  and 
Easter. 

EPHOD.  A  sacred  vestment  originally 
worn  by  the  high  priest  only,  but  after- 
wards worn  by  ordinary  priests.     Attached 


EPIPHANY 

to  the  ephod  of  the  high  priest  was  the 
breastplate  with  the  Urim  and  Thummim. 

St.  Jerome  observes  (vol.  vL  col.  32, 
Comment,  in  Hosea)  that  the  ephod  was 
culiar  to  the  priesthood  (significat  indu- 
mentum sacerdotale) ;  and  it  was  an  opinion 
among  the  Jews,  that  no  sort  of  worship,  true 
or  false,  could  subsist  without  a  priesthood 
and  ephod. 

EPIGO NATION  (eViyovanoc,  from  yoi/v, 
a  knee).  An  appendage  of  a  lozenge  shape, 
somewhat  resembling  a  small  maniple,  worn 
on  the  right  side,  depending  from  the  girdle. 
It  is  considered  to  represent  the  napkin  with 
which  our  Blessed  Lord  girded  himself  at  the 
last  supper,  and  has  embroidered  on  it  either 
a  cross  or  the  head  of  our  Lord.  In  the 
Koman  Church  its  use  is  confined  to  the 
pope.  In  the  Greek  Church  it  is  used  by 
all  bishops.  The  epigonation  does  not  oc- 
cur in  the  sacerdotal  vestments  of  the 
English  Church. — Palmer,  Grig.  Liturg.  ii. 
in  Jin. ;  Ducange,  Oloss. 

EPIPHANY.  (Derived  from  the  com- 
pound verb  ivK^aivfiv,  to  manifest  or 
declare.)  The  Epiphany,  or  manifestation 
of  Christ  to  the  Gentiles,  is  commemorated 
in  the  Church  on  the  6th  of  January. 

I.  Epiphany  was  not  originally  a  distinct 
festival,  but  made  a  part  of  that  of  the 
nativity  of  Christ.  This  was  celebrated 
during  twelve  days,  the  first  and  last  of 
which,  according  to  the  custom  of  the  Jews 
in  their  feasts,  were  high  or  chief  days  of 
solemnity,  and  therefore  either  of  these 
might  fitly  be  called  Epiphany,  as  that 
word  signifies  the  appearance  of  Christ  in 
the  world  (See  Christmas). 

Those  who  observed  it  as  a  distinct  festival 
from  the  Nativity  did  it  at  first  chiefly  on 
account  of  our  Saviour's  baptism,  and  after- 
wards from  the  appearing  of  the  Star  which 
conducted  the  wise  men  of  the  East  to  the 
Saviour.  Other  reasons  were  also  given, 
namely,  the  turning  water  into  vrine  at 
Cana,  and  the  feeding  of  the  five  thousand — 
thus  "  God  manifesting  Himself  by  miracles 
in  human  nature"  (Aug.  Serm.  xxix.  de 
Tempore).  St.  Jerome,  indeed,  insists  only 
upon  the  commemoration  of  our  Saviour's 
baptism  (in  Ezeh.  i.),  and  St.  Chrysostom 
says,  "  Why  is  not  the  day  on  which  Christ 
was  born  called  Epiphany,  but  the  day  on 
which  he  was  baptized  ?  Because  he  was 
not  manifested  to  all  when  he  was  born, 
but  when  he  was  baptized  "  (Homil.  xxiv. 
de  Bapt.  Christi).  So  also  Gregory  Nazi- 
anzen  :  "  This  holy  day  of  lights  had  its 
origin  from  the  baptism  of  Christ,  the  true 
Light"  {Orat.  xxxix.).  So  in  the  Eastern 
Church  this  became  one  of  the  days  for 
baptism,  and  was  called  also  the  day  of 
light  (Jjiicpa  Tuv  (fxirav),  baptism  being 
generally  called   <f>S>s  and  {parurna.     And 


EPIPHANY 

St.  Chrysostom  tells  us,  tliat,  this  being 
likewise  the  day  of  our  Saviour's  baptism,  it 
was  usual  to  carry  home  water  at  midnight 
from  the  church,  and  that  it  would  remain 
as  fresh  and  uncorrupt  for  one,  two,  or  three 
years,  as  if  immediately  drawn  from  the 
spring  (De  ■  Bapt.  '  Ghristi,  ut  supra). 
Dr.  Neale  supposes  that  it  partly  had  this 
name  from  the  great  array  of  torches  and 
tapers  with  which  the  benediction  of  the 
waters  is  performed  on  this  day  (^Hist.  of 
Holy  Eastern  Church) ;  and  reference  is 
made  to  this  by  early  writers.  The 
primitive  name  of  the  day  was  Theophania, 
and  both  this  and  Bpiphania  are  used  in 
the  Comes  of  St.  Jerome  and  the  Saoramen- 
tary  of  St.  Gregory ;  but  the  former  died 
out  as  the  festival  became  more  exclusively 
connected  with  the  call  and  adoration  of 
the  Magi — the  first-fruits  of  the  Gentiles. 
The  Western  Church  generally  adopted  the 
latter  idea,  and  the  eight  homilies  of  Leo  L 
(a.d.  440)  assign  no  other  rationale  for  the 
observance  of  the  Epiphany. 

Theodosius  the  Younger  gave  this  festival 
an  honourable  place  among  those  days, 
on  which  the  public  games  were  not  al- 
lowed; and  Justinian  made  it  a  day  of 
vacation  from  all  pleadings  at  law,  as  well 
as  from  popular  pleasures.  It  is  to  be  ob- 
served, likewise,  that  those  to  whom  the 
care  of  the  Paschal  cycle,  or  rule  for  find- 
ing Easter,  was  committed,  were  obliged, 
on  or  about  the  time  of  Epiphany,  to  give 
public  notice  when  Easter  and  Lent  were 
to  be  kept  the  ensuing  year.— Coc?.  Theod. 
lib.  XV.  tit.  5,  leg.  5  ;  God.  Just.  lib.  iii.  tit. 
12,  leg.  6. 

IL  The  Feast  of  Epiphany  is  mentioned 
in  all  the  ancient  liturgies,  and  generally 
there  is  also  a  form  for  the  vigil.  In  the 
Sacramentary  of  Gregory  there  is  also 
a  form  for  the  octave;  it  is  from  this 
sacramentary  that  our  collect  is  taken.  A 
Sunday  before  Epiphany  is  denoted  in  the 
Mozarabic  or  Spanish  Missal,  as  in  the 
Breviary.  The  three  manifestations  (to  the 
Magi,  at  the  Baptism,  at  the  Marriage  Feast) 
are  generally  indicated  in  the  Scriptures 
appointed  in  the  liturgies ;  and  sometimes, 
as  in  the  so-called  Gothico-Gallic  Missal, 
reference  is  made  to  the  feeding  of  the  five 
thousand.  The  second  lessons  for  morning 
and  evening  service  in  our  Prayer  Book 
refer  to  the  manifestation  of  our  Lord's 
Divine  Sonship  at  His  baptism,  and  of  his 
Divine  Power  ("  manifesting  forth  his 
glory."  St.  John  ii.  11)  at  the  marriage  in 
Cana. 

III.  It  has  always  been  the  tradition  that 
the  Magi  were  three  in  number,  and  that 
the  remainder  of  their  lives  after  the  visit 
to  the  Holy  Land  was  spent  in  the  service 
of  God.     They  are  said  to  have  been  bap- 


EPISTLE 


329 


tized  by  St.  Thomas,  and  to  have  died  as 
martyrs  for  the  Faith.  Their  supposed 
relics  are  in  a  gorgeous  shrine  at  Cologne, 
the  names  given  to  them  being  Gaspar, 
Melchior,  and  Balthazar. 

An  interesting  custom  used  to  be  observed 
at  the  Chapel  Eoyal  in  St.  James's  Palace 
on  this  festival.  The  sovereign  proceeded 
to  the  altar  at  the  time  of  the  offertory,  and 
made  an  offering  of  gold,  frankincense,  and 
myrrh,  which  was  laid  upon  the  altar,  com- 
memorating the  oflferings  of  the  Magi.  An 
ofScer  of  the  royal  household  now  makes 
the  offering  in  the  name  of  the  sovereign. — 
Bingham,  bk.  xx.  c.  iv. ;  Martene,  de  Eit. 
iii.  42  ;  Suicer  in  voc.  and  p.  1196 ;  Blunt's 
Annot.  P.  B.  p.  83. 

EPISCOPACY.  The  ancient  apostolical 
form  of  Church  government,  consisting  in 
the  superintendency  of  one  over  several 
other  church  officers.  Bishops  were  always 
allowed  to  be  of  an  order  superior  to  pres- 
byters ;  and,  indeed,  having  all  the  powers 
that  presbyters  have,  and  some  more  pe- 
culiar to  themselves,  they  must  he  of  a 
different  order  necessarily.  It  is  their  pe- 
culiar office  to  ordain,  which  never  was 
allowed  to  presbyters;  and,  anciently,  the 
presbyter  acted  in  dependence  upon  the 
bishop  in  the  administration  of  the  Lord's 
supper  and  baptism,  and  even  in  preaching, 
in  such  manner  that  he  could  not  do  it  re- 
gularly without  the  bishop's  approbation. 

Our  Church  asserts,  in  the  preface  to 
the  Ordinal,  that  the  order  of  bishops  was 
"  from  the  apostles'  time ;  "  referring  us  to 
those  texts  of  Scripture  occurring  in  the 
history  of  the  Acts,  and  the  apostolical 
Epistles,  which  are  usually  urged  for  the 
proof  of  the  episcopal  order  (See  Bishop, 
Archbishop,  Orders). 

EPISTLE.  L  The  Scriptural  Epistles 
are  letters  which  were  addressed  by  the  in- 
spired Apostles  to  Churches  or  individuals. 

Of  these,  the  Apostle  Paul  wrote  four- 
teen; if  we  include  the  Epistle  to  the 
Hebrews,  about  the  authorship  of  which 
there  is  considerable  doubt.  St.  James  and 
St.  Jude  each  wrote  one,  St.  Peter  two,  and 
St.  John  three  general  Epistles. 

II.  But  by  the  Epistle  in  the  liturgy  we 
mean  the  first  lesson  in  the  Communion 
Service,  which  is  so  styled  because  it  is 
generally  taken  from  the  Epistles  of  the 
holy  apostles.  Sometimes,  however,  it  is 
taken  from  the  Acts,  and  occasionally  from 
the  prophets,  but  then  it  is  termed  the 
portion  of  Scripture  appointed  for  the 
Epistle.  Almost  all  the  lessons  now  read 
as  Epistles  in  the  English  liturgy  have 
been  assigned  to  their  present  place,  and 
used  by  our  Church,  for  many  ages.  They 
are  found  in  all  the  liturgies  of  our  Church 
used  before  the   revision,  in   the  reign  of 


830 


EPISXOLAEIUM 


Edward  VI.,  and  they  also  appear  in  all  the 
monuments  of  the  English  liturgy  before 
the  invasion  of  "William  the  Conqueror.  It 
is,  in  fact,  probable  that  they  are  generally 
as  old  as  the  time  of  Augustine,  a.d.  597. 
In  this  view,  the  lessons  entitled  Epistles 
in  our  liturgy  have  been  used,  with  some 
alterations,  for  1200  years  by  the  Church  of 
England.  The  most  ancient  collection  of 
Epistles  and  Gospels  is  the  "  Comes  of  St. 
Jerome"  (See  Comes).  It  contains  Epistles 
and  Gospels  for  all  the  Sundays  of  the  year, 
and  most  of  the  Festivals.  The  Roman 
lectionary  differs  considerably  from  it,  but 
the  English  is  generally  in  accord.  In  the 
Sarum  Use,  for  instance,  and  in  our  Prayer 
Book,  the  Epistles  and  Gospels  for  the 
Sundays  after  Trinity  are  the  same  as 
those  appointed  in  the  Comes,  but  in  the 
Roman  rite  they  are  different.  The  prin- 
ciple of  selection  is  clear.  Prom  Advent  to 
Trinity  the  leading  events  in  our  Lord's  life. 
His  Resurrection  and  Ascension,  and  the 
descent  of  the  Holy  Spirit,  are  commemo- 
rated on  what  are  called  the  Great  Festivals. 
From  Trinity  to  Advent  our  practical  duties 
as  Christians  are  set  forth. 

EPISTOLAEIUM.  A  service  book  in 
wMch  are  contained  the  Epistles  for  the 
office  of  Holy  Communion  (See  Evangelis- 
tarium ;  Maskell,  i.  cl.). 

EPISTOLBR.  The  minister  wbo  reads 
the  Epistle  and  acts  as  sub-deacon,  or 
helper,  at  a  celebration.  In  the  24th  canon, 
and  in  the  injunctions  of  Queen  Elizabeth, 
we  find  that  a  special  reader,  entitled  an 
epistoler,  is  to  read  the  Epistle  in  collegiate 
churches,  vested  in  a  cope.  The  canon  and 
the  injunctions  here  referred  to  wUl  be 
found  under  the  head  Cathedral. 

Epistolers  are  still  statutable  officers  in 
several  cathedrals  of  the  new  foundation: 
though  in  most  the  institution  has  fallen 
into  desuetude.  It  is  retained  at  Durham. 
The  epistoler  and  gospeller  are  sometimes 
called  deacon  and  sub-deacon,  in  the  cathe- 
dral statutes.  By  Archbishop  Grindal  s  In- 
jimctions  in  1571,  it  was  required  that 
parish  clerks  should  be  able  to  read  the  first 
Lesson  and  Epistle. 

EPITAPH  (f TTt,  TCLC^oi).  An  inscription 
on  a  monument  in  honom-  or  memory  of 
the  dead.  In  the  catacombs  of  Rome, 
inscriptions,  sacred  emblems,  and  marks  of 
the  sex  or  profession  of  the  dead  were 
carved  or  smeared  on  slabs  which  enclosed 
the  tomb.  Though,  as  a  rule,  each  recess 
contained  a  single  body,  yet  sometimes  it 
was  of  a  capacity  to  receive  two,  three,  or 
more  corpses.  These  were  called  hisomi, 
trisomi,  quadrisomi,  &c.,  and  such  epitaphs 
were  engraved  on  them  as  "  Hostavie  coivgi 
neofite  bisomv.  maritus  fecit;"  "  Seberus, 
Leontius  Bictorinus,  Trisomu  "  (Bosio,  Roma 


EPITAPH 

Soiteranea,  pp.  216,  507).  Many  slabs- 
have  been  discovered  bearing  names  such 
as  Anteros  (a.d.  236),  Fabian  (a.d.  251), 
Lucius  (a.d.  253),  and  others,  with  the 
words  "  Episcopus,"  "  Martyr  "  (in  the  case  of 
Fabian),  or  other  inscriptions  in  the  Greek 
character  (De  Rossi,  Inscript.  Christ.). 
When  St.  Jerome  visited  the  catacombs 
(c.  A.D.  354),  they  seem  not  to  have  been 
used  as  the  general  cemeteries  (Hieron.  in 
Ezech.  c.  xl.),  but  the  custom  of  putting 
epitaphs  on  tombs  remained ;  and  the 
tendency  to  raise  very  costly  memorials- 
was  such  that  SS.  Basil  and  Chrysostom 
inveighed  against  the  reckless  extravagance. 
In  England  it  was  very  often  the  case 
that  standing  stones,  probably  associated 
with  idolatrous  worship,  were  made  use  of, 
and  Christianized  by  the  engraving  of  a, 
cross  on  them  (See  Monuments).  In 
Wales  and  Brittany  there  are  frequent 
examples  of  this.  The  earliest  church 
tombs  in  this  country  are  of  the  eleventh 
and  twelfth  centuries.  They  were  ridged 
in  form,  and  covered  with  a  cross,  or,  in  the 
the  later  period,  a  recumbent  figure.  Then 
came  tombs  recessed  in  the  wall ;  and  soon 
followed  the  high  tomb  and  effigy  detached 
from  the  wall,  and  placed  under  a  canopy, 
from  which  the  advance  to  chantry  chapels^ 
was  easy.  In  these  the  epitaph  or  in- 
scription is  sometimes  placed  round  or  at 
the  back  of  the  tomb,  but  often  the  effigy 
or  monument  was  considered  sufficient 
without  an  epitaph.  In  the  ancient  Latin 
inscriptions  on  tombs,  either  from  careless- 
ness or  ignorance  of  the  workmen,  curious- 
mistakes  in  orthography  and  grammar  oc- 
curred. Thus  we  find  Eossa,  for  ossa, 
Sordine  for  ordine,  Zfoctobres  and  fletema 
for  Octobres  and  Etema ;  on  the  other  hand, 
oc  appears  for  hoc,  ic  for  hie,  Onorius  for 
Honorius.  The  cases  also  got  confused, 
accusatives  being  used  for  ablatives,  as  for 
instance,  "  cum  quern  vLxit ; "  "  cum  tixorem 
suam ; "  "  pro  nunc  unum  sobolem  era ; " 
"  decessit  de  saeculum,"  &c.  (De  Rossi,  Ins. 
Urb.  Rom.  pp.  82,  103,  133).  Similar 
Ignorance  or  carelessness  is  displayed  in 
many  English  churchyards  in  the  eighteenth 
and  beginning  of  the  nineteenth  centuries. 
It  would  appear  that  the  clei'gy  in  that  dull 
time  of  the  Church  did  not  care  about  the 
matter,  or  at  all  events  did  not  use  that 
power  of  veto  which  [they  possessed  then, 
though  the  churchyards  are  now  taken  out 
of  their  hands.     Such  epitaphs  as 


and 


'*  Cease  now  dear  friend,  and  weep  no  more, 
I  are  not  dead  but  gone  before," 

(Porlock  Churchyard,) 

*My  dearest  friends  advised  he. 
Weep  for  yourselves  and  not  for  we," 


are  frequent  in  country  churchyards.    But 


EPOCH 

sucli,  in  later  years,  have  not  been  allowed, 
and  at  all  events,  grammar  and  orthography 
are  regarded  as  essential  in  epitaphs. 

EPOCH.  A  term  in  chronology  signi- 
fying a  fixed  point  of  time  from  which  the 
succeeding  years  are  numbered.  The  first 
epoch  is  the  creation  of  the  world,  which, 
according  to  the  Vulgate  Bible,  Arch- 
bishop Ussher  fixes  in  the  year  710  of  the 
Julian  periods,  and  4004  years  before 
Jesus  Christ.  The  second  is  the  Deluge, 
which,  according  to  the  Hebrew  text, 
happened  in  the  year  of  the  world  1656. 
Six  other  epochs  are  commonly  reckoned 
in  sacred  history :  the  building  of  the 
tower  of  Babel ;  the  calUng  of  Abraham ; 
the  departure  of  the  Israelites  out  of 
Egypt ;  the  dedication  of  the  temple ;  the 
end  of  the  Babylonish  captivity;  and  the 
birth  of  Jesus  Christ.  In  ancient  profane 
history  four  epochs  are  frequently  reckoned  : 
the  "  sera  "  of  Nabonassar,  or  death  of  Sar- 
danapalus ;  the  reign  of  Cyrus  at  Babylon ; 
the  reign  of  Alexander  the  Great  over  the 
Persians ;  and  the  beginning  of  the  reign  of 
Augustus,  in  which  our  Saviom-  was  bom. 

ERA.  A  term  often  used  as  synonymous 
■with  "epoch";  the  difference  really  being 
that  the  latter  implies  some  specified  event, 
the  former  a  succession  of  years  reckoned 
on  some  common  principle  from  that  event. 
The  idea  of  the  Christian  era,  the  epoch 
being  the  birth  of  Christ,  was  first  intro- 
duced by  Dionysius  Exiguus  about  a.d. 
532.  He  supposed  Clirist  to  have  been 
bom  on  the  25th  December,  in  the  year  of 
Rome  753,  Lentulus  and  Piso  being  consuls, 
and  this  computation  has  been  followed  to 
the  present  day.  It  is  now  generally  ac- 
knowledged that  this  is  not  the  true  year 
of  our  Saviour's  birth,  but  it  has  been  used 
so  long  as  an  epoch  for  the  Christian  era 
that  it  could  not  be  altered. — Bingham,  bk. 
XX.  c.  4 ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim  (note),  i.  31. 

ERASTIANISM.  A  term  derived  from 
Erastus,  a  Grecised  form  for  Lieber,  the 
name  of  a  physician  of  Heidelberg,  who 
lived  A.D.  1524-1583.  His  name  and 
principles  were  brought  into  prominence  in 
England  at  the  time  of  the  Great  Rebellion. 
He  had.  written  a  number  of  Tlieses,  which  he 
afterwards  collected  into  a  work  called  a 
Book  on  Excommunication,  in  which  he  op- 
posed the  rigid  discipline  of  the  Calvinists 
with  great  force,  while  at  the  same  time 
he  asserted  that  there  was  no  authority 
over  reUgion  except  the  State.  The 
pastoral  office,  according  to  him,  was  only 
persuasive,  like  that  of  a  jDrofessor  of  science 
over  his  students.  The  minister  might 
dissuade  the  vicious  and  unqualified  from 
the  communion,  but  might  not  refuse  it, 
or  inflict  any  kind  of  censure ;  the  punish- 
ment of  all  offences,  either  of  a  civil  or 


ESTHEIl 


331 


religious  nature,  being  referred  to  the  civil 
magistrate.  These  principles  were  taken 
up  by  the  Independents  against  the  Pres- 
byterians in  1043,  the  chief  exponent!* 
being  Seldeu,  Coleman,  vicar  of  Blyton  in 
Lincolnshire,  and  Dr.  Lightfoot.  A  ten- 
dency to  resist  all  ecclesiastical  authority, 
to  assert  individual  opinion  against  the 
Church's  doctrines,  and  to  regard  Parlia- 
ment as  the  chief  authority  even  in  ec- 
clesiastical matters,  are  the  characteristics 
of  Brastians.  Hobbes  expresses  the  idea 
by  stating  that  Christianity  is  not  obli- 
gatory on  any  one  unless  made  so  by  Act 
of  Parliament,  or  other  competent  autho- 
rity.— Hobbes'  Leviathan,  iii.  42. 

ESPOUSE,  ESPOUSALS.  L  A  cere- 
mony of  betrothing,  or  coming  under  obli- 
gation for  the  purpose  of  marriage.  It 
was  a  mutual  agreement  between  the  two 
parties,  which  usually  preceded  the  mar- 
riage some  considerable  time.  The  dis- 
tinction between  espousals  and  marriaga 
ought  to  be  carefully  attended  to,  as 
espousals  in  the  East  are  sometimes  con- 
tracted for  years  before  the  patties  cohabit, 
and  sometimes  in  very  early  youth.  The 
two  contracts  have  long  been  placed  to- 
gether by  our  Church  (See  Betrothal). 

II.  The  ceremony  is  alluded  to  figura- 
tively, as  between  God  and  His  people. 
(Jer.  ii.  2),  to  whom  He  was  a  husband 
(Jer.  xxxi.  32).  The  apostle  St.  Paul  says 
that  he  acted  as  a  kind  of  assistant  (pro- 
nuba)  to  his  Corinthian  converts  (2  Cor. 
xi.  2) :  "I  have  espoused  you  to  Christ," 
that  is,  I  have  drawn  up  the  writings, 
settled  the  agreements,  given  pledges,  &c., 
of  that  union  (See  Isa.  liv.  5 ;  St.  Matt. 
XXV.  6 ;  Rev.  xix.). 

ESTABLISHMENT  OP  THE  CHURCH 
(See  Endowment). 

ESTHER,  The  Book  of,  is  a  canonical 
book  of  Scripture.  There  has  been  some  dis- 
pute whether  it  was  a  canonical  book  among 
the  Jews.  St.  Jerome  and  other  Christian 
writers  maintain  the  affirmative,  but  St. 
Athanasius  and  some  others  incline  to 
the  opposite  conclusion.  It  has,  however, 
been  received  as  canonical  by  the  Church. 
The  last  six  chapters,  beginning  at  the 
fourth  verse  of  the  tenth  chapter,  ai-e  not 
in  the  Hebrew  text.  These  are  probably 
a  collection  of  several  pieces  put  together 
by  the  Hellenistical  Jews,  and  are  therefore 
deservedly  thrown  out  of  the  canon  of  the 
sacred  books  by  the  Protestant  Church ;  but 
the  Latin  and  Greek  Churches  hold  them 
canonical.  As  to  the  author  of  the  Book  of 
Esther,  there  is  great  uncertainty.  Many  of 
the  Christian  Fathers  attribute  this  history 
to  Ezra.  Eusebius  believes  it  to  be  more 
modem.  Others  ascribe  it  to  Joachim  the 
high  priest,  the  grandson  of  Josedec.     Most 


332 


ETERNITY 


conceive  Mordecai  to  have  been  the  author 
of  it,  and  join  Esther  with  him  in  the  com- 
position of  it.  It  has  been  remarked,  as  a 
singular  circumstance,  that  the  Divine  name 
•does  not  once  occur  in  tliis  book  (See 
Speaker's  Commentary). 

ETERNITY.  That  mysterious  attri- 
bute of  God  which  implies  his  existence,  as 
without  end,  so  without  beginning.  The 
self-e.itistent  Being  must  of  necessity  be 
eternal.  The  ideas  of  eternity  and  self- 
existence  are  so  closely  connected,  that, 
because  something  must  of  necessity  be 
eternal,  independently  and  without  any 
outward  cause  of  its  being,  therefore  it 
must,  necessarily  be  self-existent;  and, 
because  it  is  impossible  but  something 
must  be  self-existent,  therefore  it  is  ne- 
cessary that  it  must  likewise  be  eternal. 
To  be  self-existent,  is  to  exist  by  an 
absolute  necessity  in  the  nature  of  the 
thing  itself.  Now  this  necessity  being 
absolute,  and  not  depending  upon  any- 
thing external,  must  be  always  unalterably 
the  same,  nothing  being  alterable  but  what 
is  capable  of  being  affected  by  somewhat 
without  itself.  That  being,  therefore, 
which  has  no  other  cause  of  its  existence 
but  the  absolute  necessity  of  its  own  na- 
ture, must,  of  necessity,  have  existed  from 
everlasting,  without  beginning,  and  must, 
of  necessity,  exist  to  everlasting,  without 
end. 

As  to  the  manner  of  this  eternal  exis- 
tence, it  is  manifest  it  herein  infinitely 
transcends  the  manner  of  the  existence  of 
all  created  beings,  even  of  such  as  shall 
exist  for  ever ;  that  whereas  it  is  not  pos- 
sible for  their  finite  minds  to  comprehend 
all  that  is  past,  or  to  understand  perfectly 
all  things  that  are  present,  much  less  to 
know  all  that  is  future,  or  to  have  entirely 
in  their  power  anything  that  is  to  come, 
but  their  thoughts,  and  knowledge,  and 
power,  must,  of  necessity,  have  degrees 
and  periods,  and  be  successive  and  tran- 
sient as  the  things  themselves :  the  eter- 
nal, supreme  cause,  on  the  contrary,  must 
of  necessity  have  such  a  perfect,  indepen- 
dent, unchangeable  comprehension  of  all 
things,  that  there  can  be  no  one  point  or 
instant  of  his  eternal  duration,  wherein  all 
things  that  are  past,  present,  and  to  come, 
will  not  be  as  entirely  known  and  repre- 
sented to  him  in  one  single  thought  or 
view,  and  all  things  present  and  future  be 
as  equally  and  entirely  in  his  power  and 
direction,  as  if  there  was  really  no  succes- 
sion at  all,  but  all  things  were  actually 
present  at  once. — Dr.  Clarke,  Demonstra- 
tion of  tlie  Being  and  Attributes  of  God. 

This  is,  in  reality,  the  most  incompre- 
hensible of  the  divine  attributes.  Gfod  is 
without  beginning ;  the  Father,  always  a 


EUCHARIST 

Father,  without  beginning;  the  Son,  al- 
ways the  only  begotten  of  the  Father, 
without  beginning ;  the  Holy  Ghost,  al- 
ways proceeding  from  the  Father  and 
the  Son,  without  beginning;  the  one  God, 
always  existing  in  the  Trinity  of  his  per- 
sons, without  beginning. 

"  There  is  but  one  living  and  true  God, 
everlasting,  without  body,  parts,  or  pas- 
sions ;  of  infinite  power,  wisdom,  and  good- 
ness ;  the  inaker  and  preserver  of  all  things 
visible  and  invisible ;  and  in  the  unity  of 
this  Godhead,  there  be  Three  Persons,  of 
one  substance,  power,  and  eternity,  the 
Father,  the  Son,  and  the  Holy  Ghost." 
— Article  I. 

ETHELDREDA,  Virgin,— commemora- 
ted in  the  English  Calendar  on  October  17. 
She  was  the  daughter  of  an  East  Anglian 
king,  and  niece  of  St.  Hilda,  the  Abbess  of 
Whitby.  For  many  years  she  was  abbess 
of  a  convent  at  Ely,  which  she  herself  had 
founded.  Her  popular  name  was  St.  Audry, 
from  which  is  said  to  be  derived  our  word 
"  taudry,"  because  cheap  finery  was  sold  at 
"St.  Audry's  fair." — Stanley's  Canterbury 
Cathedral,  note,  p.  236. 

EUCHARIST.  I.  The  word  fvxapurria, 
eucliarist,  originally  signified  a  "  sense 
of  gratitude  or  thankfulness"  (2  Mace, 
ii.  27;  Acts  xxiv.  3).  Such  a  sense  of 
thankfulness  may  be  expressed  either  in 
word  or  in  act. 

II.  With  the  idea  of  verbal  thanksgiving 
both  the  verb  tlxapi-TTfiv  and  the  sub- 
stantive eixapiarla,  are  often  used  in  the  New 
Testament.  Thus  we  find  the  verb  applied 
(St.  Luke  xvii.  16)  to  the  grateful  leper 
who  returned  and  gave  thanks  to  our  Lord ; 
to  St.  Paul,  who  seeing  the  brethren  at 
Appii  forum,  he  thanked  Cod,  and  took 
courage  (Acts  xxviii.  15) ;  to  the  joy  of  the 
same  Apostle  when  he  thanked  God  for  every 
remembrance  of  the  believers  at  Philippi 
(Phil.  i.  3);  to  our  Lord,  when  at  the 
feeding  of  the  Four  Thousand,  He  took  the 
seven  loaves  and  the  fishes,  and  gave  thanks 
(St.  Matt.  XV.  36). 

Again,  we  find  the  substantive  dxapioTia 
used  of  thanksgiving  generally,  as  when 
TertuUus  thanks  Felix  for  Ms  services  to  the 
Jewish  nation  (Acts  xxiv.  3),  and  especially 
of  thanksgiving  in  public  worship,  as  when 
St.  Paul  says  to  the  Corinthians  "  how  shall 
he  that  occupieth  the  room  of  the  vmlearned 
say  Amen  at  thy  giving  of  tlianks  "  (1  Cor. 
xiv.  16). 

III.  Not  a  few  hold  that  here  the  Apostle 
is  speaking  of  the  thanksgiving  offered  to 
God  at  the  Lord's  Supper.  That  thankfulness 
in  word  soon  merged  into  thankfulness  in  act, 
and  so  evxapioria  came  to  denote  a  thank- 
offering,  is  certain.  For  PhUo  describes  it 
as  including  hymns,  prayers,  and  sacrifices. 


EUCHARIST 

and  speaks  of  thant -offerings  expressed 
by  sacrifices.  But,  wlietlier  the  word  in 
the  above  passage  from  1  Corinthians  is  or 
is  not  to  be  applied  to  the  Lord's  Supper, 
it  cannot  be  disputed  that  the  verb 
evxapLorelv  plays  an  important  part  in 
every  account  of  its  institution.  Thus  St. 
Paul  and  St.  Luke  aUke  tell  us  that  at  the 
Lord's  Supper  our  Lord  "  took  bread,"  and 
"  when  He  had  given  thanks,  He  brake  it "  (1 
Cor.  xi.  24 ;  St.  Luke  xxii.  19) ;  and  likewise 
we  are  told  that  after  taking  the  cup  He  gave 
thanks,  and  gave  to  them  (St.  Matt.  xxvi.  27). 
Thus  giving  thanks  was  one  of  His  most 
significant  actions ;  and  Justin  Martyr  tells 
us  in  his  Apology  (i.  65)  that  the  brother 
who  presided  at  the  primitive  celebrations  of 
the  Lord's  Supper,  receiving  bread  and  a  cup 
of  water  and  mixed  wine,  sends  up  praise 
and  glory  to  the  Father  of  all,  through  the 
Name  of  the  Son  and  the  Holy  Spirit,  and 
offers  a  thanksgiving  (euxaptoTiav)  at  some 
length  for  that  He  hath  vouchsafed  to  us 
these  blessings." 

rV.  From  the  utterance  of  thanksgiving 
over  the  elements  of  bread  and  wine  at 
the  celebration  of  the  Lord's  Supper,  the 
verb  fux^P'""""  came  to  denote  further  "  to 
r/msecrate,  or  hallow  by  word  of  thanks- 
giving." Thus,  in  the  passage  quoted  above, 
Justin  Martyr,  after  mentioning  the  thanks- 
giving of  the  brother  who  presided,  speaks 
of  the  bread  and  wine  and  water  as 
made  eucharistic,  evxapi.(TTr\6tvTos  aprov  kol 
oti-ou  Koi  vbaros  {Apol.  i.  65),  and  of 
the  food  as  "  consecrated  "  (Apol.  i.  66) ;  and 
Irenaeus  speaks  of  the  ■  bread  after  the 
Epidesis  or  invocation,  as  no  longer  common 
bread,  but  eixapurna,  consisting  of  two 
parts,  an  earthly  and  a  heavenly  (Essres. 
iv.  18,  5). 

V.  But  Justin  Martyr  uses  also  language 
which  shows  that  he  regarded  the  elements 
as  constituting  in  themselves  a  thank- 
offering,  for  :in  his  dialogue  with  Trypho 
he  speaks  of  the  leper's  offering  of  five 
flowers,  a  type  of  "  the  Bread  of  the  Eu- 
charist," "which  the  Lord  commanded  us 
to  offer  in  thanksgiving."  And  similarly, 
when  Celsus  urged  against  the  Christians 
that  they  were  ungrateful  in  not  paying  due 
thank-offerings  to  the  gods  of  the  country, 
Origen  repUes  that  the  bread  called  eixapur- 
Tta  was  the  outward  token  of  thankfulness 
toward  God  (c.  Cehwm,  viii.  57). 

AT.  From  all  this  it  is  easy  to  see  how  the 
Eucharist  became  one  of  the  special  names  of 
the  Lord's  Supper.  Thus  in  the  Didache,  or 
"  Teaching  of  the  Apostles  "  (c.  a.d.  90-100), 
we  read :  "  but  vrith  regard  to  the  Eucharist, 
give  thanks  after  this  manner  "  (ix.  1) ;  and 
again,  "Let  no  one  eat  or  drink  of  your 
Eucharist  except  thosebaptisedinto  the  name 
of  the  Lord"  (ix.  5).    And  again  we  find 


EUCHARISTIC 


333 


Clement  of  Alexandria  speaking  of  the  priests 
as  distributing  "  the  Eucharist"  i.e.  the 
Elements,  to  the  communicants  {Strom,  i.  5), 
and  Eusebius  speaks  of  sending  "  the  Eu- 
charist "  to  the  neighbouring  Churches  (//.  E. 
V.  24, 15).  Prom  the  East  the  word  found  its 
way  into  the  West,  and  the  Latin  Fathers 
adopted  the  same  Greek  word  into  their 
language.  Thus  Cyprian  {Epist.  xv.  c.  1) 
explains  "  Eucharistia "  as  "Sanctum 
Domini  Corpus,"  the  sacred  Body  of  the- 
Lord,  and  TertuUian  says  that  "  in  the 
Eucharist  our  Lord  did  not  institute  a  figure 
of  His  Body." 

VII.  Having  once  been  adopted  by  the 
Latin  Fathers  the  word  became  common 
enough  in  the  West,  and  hence  the  name 
Sacramentum  Eucharistise  is  the  name 
given  to  the  Lord's  Supper  in  the  28thi 
Article,  and  in  the  same  Article  the  words 
occur,  "  Panis  et  Vini  trans  ubstantiatio  in 
Eucharistia.^' 

VIII.  The  propriety  of  the  name  is  obvious. 
It  fitly  denotes  this  Holy  Service  as  a 
sacrifice  of  praise  and  thanksgiving.  Tliis 
aspect  of  it  comes  out  in  many  portions  of 
our  own  office.  Thus  in  the  Exhortation  we 
are  reminded  that "  above  aU  things  we  niust 
give  most  humble  and  hearty  thanks  to  God 
the  Father,  the  Son,  and  the  Holy  Ghost, 
for  the  redemption  of  the  world  by  the 
death  and  passion  of  our  Saviour  Jesus 
Christ,  both  God  and  man ; "  and  in  the 
words  preceding  the  Sanctus,  after  bidding 
those  who  are  about  to  communicate  to 
"give  thanks  unto  our  Lord  God,  the 
celebrant  continues :  "  It  is  very  meet, 
right,  and  our  bounden  duty,  that  we  should 
at  all  times  and  in  all  places,  give  thanks  \nxio 
Thee,  0  Lord,  Holy  Father,  Almighty, 
Everlasting  God."  Again,  in  the  Post- 
Communion  Service  he  says  :  "  O  Lord  and 
heavenly  Father,  we  Thy  humble  servants 
entirely  desire  Thy  fatherly  goodness 
mercifully  to  accept  this  our  sacrifice  of 
praise  and  thanksgiving ;  "  and  again  :  "  Al- 
mighty and  everliving  God,  we  most 
heartily  thank  Thee,  for  that  Thou  dost 
vouchsafe  to  feed  us,  who  have  duly  received 
these  holy  mysteries."  Hence  also  Hymns-- 
of  Thanksgiving  after  Holy  Communion 
are  so  frequent  in  the  ancient  Liturgies,  and 
in  the  Gloria  in  Excelsis  "  We  praise,  bless,, 
worship,  glorify  and  give  thanks  to  our 
heavenly  King,  God  the  Father  Almighty,, 
for  all  His  mercies  in  the  redemption  of  the 
world."  This  completely  agrees  with  the 
words  of  the  Church  Catechism,  where  one- 
of  the  requisites  for  a  meet  participation  of 
the  Lord's  supper  is  said  to  be  "  a  lively 
faith  in  God's  mercy  through  Christ,  with 
a  thankful  remembrance  of  his  death."' 
[G.  F.  M.] 

EUCHARISTIC.     Belonging  to  the  ser- 


334 


EUCHELAION 


vice  of  the  lioly  Eucharist ;  or,  in  a  larger 
sense,  having  the  character  of  thanks- 
stiving. 

EUCHELAION  {Gr.).  The  oil  of 
prayer.  To  penitents  (in  the  Greek  Church) 
is  administered  the  sacrament  of  to  eix^aiov 
JHuchelaion,  which  is  performed  by  the 
bishop,  or  archbishop,  assisted  by  seven 
jtriests,  and  begins  with  this  prayer,  "  0 
Lord,  who  with  the  oil  of  thy  mercies 
hast  healed  the  wounds  of  our  souls,  do 
thou  sanctify  this  oil,  that  those  who  are 
anointed  therewith  may  be,  freed  from  their 
infirmities,  and  from  all  corporeal  and 
spiritual  evils."  This  oil  of  prayer  is  pure 
and  umnixed  oil,  without  any  other  com- 
position ;  a  quantity  whereof,  sufficient  to 
serve  for  the  whole  year,  is  consecrated, 
on  Wednesday  in  the  Holy  Week,  by  the 
archbishop,  or  bishop.  The  EwJielaion  of 
the  Greek  answers  to  the  Extreme  Unction 
of  the  Western  Church. — Eicaut,  Present 
State  of  the  Greek  Church ;  Suicer's  The- 
saurus (s.v.). 

BUCHITES  CEvxtrai).  A  sect  which 
arose  in  the  fourteenth  century.  They 
maintained  that  prayer  only  was  necessary 
to  salvation.  But  it  was  not  to  be  merely 
a  habit  of  prayer,  or  a  daily  assigned  time 
for  prayer,  but  prayer  was  to  be  unceasing. 
Therefore  they  gave  up  all  their  work  and 
imrsuits.  They  were  sometimes  called 
Enthusiasts,  in  allusion  to  the  perfection 
they  professed  to  have  attained  in  the  re- 
ligious life.  Epiphanius  (a.d.  400)  treats  of 
them  last  in  his  treatise  on  Heresies  (Exr. 
Ixxx.).  "  They  were  wandering  beggars, 
who  supposed  that  sins  might  be  blotted 
out  by  incessant  prayer,  whilst  they  under- 
valued all  public  worship,  and  were  led  by 
the  grossness  of  their  imagination  to  the 
most  absurd  notions  "  (Gieseler,  i.  275). 

In  the  twelfth  century  there  were  some 
■who  called  themselves  Euchites,  and  Mas- 
salians,  but  the  sect  was  obscure. 

In  the  nineteenth  century  there  is  a  sect 
■(Salvation  Army)  which  resembles  in  many 
points  the  Euchites.  Of  the  Euchites  it 
■was  said,  "Their  principles  did  not  ne- 
cessarily lead  to  vicious  conduct,  yet  they 
might  afford  occasion  for  practising  vice. 
And  accordingly,  it  is  but  seldom  that  any 
impugners  of  their  practices  do  more  than 
accuse  them  of  excessive  frivolity  in  their 
services  bordering  on  impiety.  They  did 
not  openly  separate  from  the  Church,  as 
they  professed  indifference.  In  some  places 
they  became  the  subjects  of  persecution." 
— Stubbs'  Mosheim,  vol.  i.  316;  ii.  247; 
Blunt's  Diet,  of  Sects,  150. 

EUCHOLOGION  (From  tix^,  preces, 
and  Xoyor,  sermo).  The  name  of  a  litur- 
gical book  of  the  Greek  Church,  containing 
a  collection    of   Divine   services    for    the 


EULOGI^ 

administration  of  the  sacraments,  confer- 
ring of  orders,  and  other  religious  offices : 
it  is  properly  their  ritual,  containing 
everything  relating  to  religious  ceremo- 
nies. Father  Simon  observes,  that  several 
of  the  most  considerable  divines  of  that 
Church,  in  Europe,  met  at  Rome  under 
Pope  Urban  VIII.,  to  examine  the  Eu- 
chologion:  Morinus,  who  was  one  of  the 
congregation,  mentions  this  ritual  in  his 
book  Be  Congregationibus :  the  greatest 
part  of  the  divines,  being  influenced  by 
the  sentiments  of  the  schoolmen,  were 
willing  to  reform  this  Greek  ritual  by  that 
of  the  Church  of  Home,  as  if  there  had 
been  some  heresies  in  it,  or  rather  some 
passages  which  made  the  administration- 
of  the  sacraments  invalid ;  but  some,  who 
more  perfectly  understood  the  controversy, 
opposed  the  censure  of  the  Euchologion ; 
they  proved  this  ritual  was  agreeable  to 
the  practice  of  the  Greek  Church  before 
the  schism  of  Photius,  and  that  for  this 
reason  it  could  not  be  condemned,  with- 
out condemning  all  the  old  Eastern  com- 
munion. 

In  its  simplest  state  the  EucTiologion  is 
based  on  the  litm-gies  of  Chrysostom  and 
Basil.  It  cannot  be  affirmed  that  the 
present  book  existed  before  the  eighth  cen- 
tury, though  the  Eastern  Church  must  have 
had  previously  an  office  book  corresponding 
to  it.  The  standard  authority  is  the  edition 
of  the  Euchologion,  with  notes,  by  J.  Goar, 
Paris,  1645,  which  has  been  frequently 
reprinted  (Canon  Venables  in  Diet,  of 
Clirist.  Ant.  628).     [H.] 

EUDOXIANS.  Certain  heretics  in  the 
fourth  century,  whose  founder  was  Eu- 
doxius,  bishop  first  of  Germanicia  in  Syria, 
then  of  Antioch,  and  afterwards  of  Con- 
stantinople. They  adhered  to  the  errors  of 
the  Aetians  and  Eunomians,  affirming  the 
Son  to  be  differently  affected  in  his  will 
from  the  Father,  and  made  of  nothing, 
denying  the  doctrine  of  the  Trinity. 

Gibbon  (JDecl.  and  Fall,  iii.  25,  p.  250, 
note)  speaks  of  Budoxius  as  mild  and  timid. 
But  the  historian  is  led  away  by  his  dislike 
to  the  orthodox  Christians.  One  who  made 
plots  to  get  his  different  bishoprics,  and 
who  on  baptising  the  emperor  Valens,  be- 
fore he  started  on  his  Gothic  expedition  in 
367,  extracted  from  him  a  promise  that  he 
would  persecute  the  Catholics,  could  not  be 
called  mild  or-  timid. — Nicephorus,  Eccles. 
Hist.  ix.  36  :  xi.  15 ;  Tillemont's  Memoires, 
vi.  art.  Ixx.  p.  422. 

EULOGI^  (lit.  "blessings").  A  Greek 
liturgical  word,  in  the  Apostolic  times  pro- 
bably synonymous  with  the  Eucharist,  from 
1  Cor.  X.  16 ;  but  very  soon  the  term  was 
applied  to  the  consecrated  pieces  of  bread 
which  the  bishops  and  priests  sent  to^  each 


EUNOMIANS 

•other  or  to  those  absent  for  the  keeping  up 
a  friendly  correspondence  (which  was  for- 
bidden by  the  Council  of  Laodicea,  a.d. 
■365)  :  those  presents  likewise,  which  were 
made  out  of  respect  or  obligation,  were 
■called  Eulogim. 

St.  Paulinus,  bishop  of  Nola,  about  the 
end  of  the  fourth  century,  having  sent  five 
Eulogias  at  one  time  to  Romanianus,  speaks 
to  him  in  these  terms  :  "  That  I  may  not 
"be  wanting  in  the  duties  of  brotherly  love, 
I  send  you  five  pieces  of  bread,  of  the  am- 
munition of  the  warfare  of  Jesus  Christ, 
imder  whose  standard  we  fight,  following 
the  laws  of  temperance  and  sobriety."- — 
■Paulin.  Epist.  vii.  p.  27. 

It  is  now  used  in  the  Roman  and  Eastern 
Churches  as  equivalent  to  the  "  Ranis  bene- 
dictus,"  or  bread  over  which  a  blessing  is 
pronounced,  and  which  is  distributed  to 
those  who  are  \mquaUfied  to  communicate 
<See  Diet,  of  Christ.  Ant.  i.  628 ;  Neale's 
Introd.  Hist.  East.  Church,  525). 
■  EUNOMIANS.  A  sect,  so  called  from 
Eunomius,  who  lived  in  the  fourth  century 
of  Christianity  ;  he  was  constituted  bishop  of 
Cyzicus,  and  at  first  stoutly  defended  the 
Arian  heresy,  but  afterwards  went  beyond, 
and  was  rejected  by  those  heretics.  He 
m.aintained  that  the  Father  was  of  a  different 
nature  from  the  Son,  because  no  creature 
could  be  like  his  creator-  he  held  that  the 
Son  of  God  did  not  substantially  unite 
himself  to  the  human  nature,  but  only  by 
virtue  of  his  operations :  he  affirmed 
blasphemously  that  he  knew  God  as  well  as 
Ood  himself;  and  those  that  were  baptized 
in  the  name  of  the  Holy  Trinity  he  rebap- 
tized,  and  was  so  averse  to  the  mystery, 
that  he  forbad.e  the  trinal  immersion  at 
baptism.  Upon  divulging  his  tenets,  he 
was  deposed  from  his  see,  and  afterwards 
sent  into  exile. — Socr.  Sist.  Eccles.  11.  35  ; 
Sozom.  iv.  26 :  vi.  26. 

"  Eunomianism,  as  a  cold  logical  system, 
wanted  the  elements  of  vitality,  and  not- 
withstanding its  wide  popularity  at  its 
commencement,  did  not  very  long  survive 
its  authors.  In  the  following  century  the 
body  had  dwindled  to  a  scanty  remnant." — 
Smith  and  Wace,  Did.  Clirist.  Biog.  ii.  287. 

EUNURCHUS  (or  Evortius),  St.,  bishop 
of  Orleans  in  the  fourth  century.  Beyond 
certain  legends  nothing  is  known  of  him, 
except  that  he  was  present  at  the  Council 
of  Valentia  in  374.  Commemorated  Sep- 
tember 7. 

EUSTATHIAi^S.  A  sect  m  the  fourth 
centuiy,  who  derived  their  name  from 
Eustathius,  bishop  of  Sebaste  in  Armenia. 
This  man  was  not  charged  so  much  with 
unsoundness  in  the  faith,  as  with  ill-ad- 
vised piety.  He  recommended  divorce, 
disobedience  of  children,  &c.,  and  was  the 


EVANGELICAL 


335 


occasion  of  great  disorders  and  divisions 
in  Armenia,  Rontus,  and  the  neighbour- 
ing countries.  In  consequence,  he  was 
deposed  and  his  principles  condemned  at 
the  Council  of  Gangra,  a.d.  380. — Socr. 
Hist.  Eccles.  ii.  33  ;  Stubhs'  Mosheim,  i. 

EUTYCHIANS.  Heretics  in  the  fifth 
century,  the  followers  of  the  error  of 
Eutyches,  who  being  a  Constantinopolitan 
abbot,  and  contending  against  Nestorius, 
fell  into  a  new  heresy.  He  and  his  follow- 
ers affii-med  that  Christ  was  one  thing, 
the  Word  another;  they  denied  the  flesh 
of  Christ  to  be  hke  ours,  but  said  he  had 
a  celestial  body,  which  passed  through 
the  Virgin  as  through  a  channel;  that 
there  were  two  natures  in  Christ  before 
the  hypostatical  vmion,  but  that,  after  it, 
there  was  but  one,  compounded  of  both  ; 
and  thence  concluded  that  the  Divinity 
of  Christ  both  suffered  and  died.  Being 
condemned  in  a  synod  at  Constantinople, 
Eutyches  appealed  to  the  emperor ;  after 
which,  by  the  assistance  of  Dioscorus,  bishop 
of  Alexandria,  he  obtained  a  synod  at  Ephe- 
sus,  which  was  so  unfairly  packed,  and  the 
proceedings  were  conducted  with  such 
violence,  that  it  was  called  Latrocinium,  or 
the  assembly  of  thieves  and  robbers,  where- 
in he  got  his  heresy  to  be  approved ;  how- 
ever, in  the  fourth  general  council,  under 
Marcian,  a.d.  451,  his  errors  were  a  second 
time  condemned. 

EVANGEL  (Prom  ci,  and  iyyeXla, 
"good  tidings").  The  Gospel  of  Christ. 
The  revealed  history  of  our  Blessed  Lord's 
life. 

EVANGELICAL.  Agreeable  to  the 
gospel,  or  "evangel."  In  the  strict  and 
proper  sense  of  the  word,  he  who  is  truly 
evangelical  must  be  a  true  member  of  the 
Church,  and  every  true  member  of  the 
Church  must  be  truly  evangelical.  But  it 
has;  been  used  in  a  sectarian  sense,  and 
adopted  by  those  who,  taking  the  gospel 
according  to  their  interpretation  for  their 
foundation,  reject  dogmatic  and  Church 
teaching — as  by  the  Evangelical  Associa- 
tion of  America,  which  in  1871  numbered 
60,241  members  :  the  Evangelical  Union, 
or  Morisonians  in  Scotland:  the  Evangeli- 
cal Lutherans  in  Germany,  &c.  The  name 
has  sometimes  been  given  to  those  persons 
who  conform  to  the  Church,  but  whose 
notions  are  supposed  more  nearly  to  coincide 
with  the  opinions  of  Dissenters  than  with 
the  doctrines  of  the  Church ;  thereby  im- 
plying that  the  principles  of  all  consistent 
members  of  the  Church  are  not  according 
to  the  gospel.  The  party  called  "  evan- 
gelical" in  the  Church  of  England  did  a 
good  work,  and  the  names  of  Scott, 
Newton,  Simeon,  Venn,  and  many  others, 
will  ever   be  revered   for  their  piety  and 


33G 


EVANGELISTS 


labour  in  the  Clmrcli  of  Christ.  The  use 
of  tenns  of  distinction  however,  among 
members  of  the  Church,  is  much  to  be 
reprobated:  among  sects  it  cannot  be 
avoided. 

EVANGELISTS.  Persons  chosen  by 
the  apostles  to  preach  the  gospel ;  it  being 
impracticable  for  the  twelve  only  to  preach 
the  gospel  to  all  the  world.  PhiUp,  among 
others,  was  engaged  in  this  function.  As 
for  their  rank  in  the  Church,  St.  Paul 
places  them  after  the  apostles  and  prophets, 
but  before  the  pastors  and  teachers  (Eph. 
iv.  11),  which  makes  Theodoret  call  them 
apostles  of  the  second  rank :  they  had  no 
particular  flock  assigned,  as  bishops  or 
ordinary  pastors,  but  travelled  from  one 
place  to  another,  according  to  their  instruc- 
tions received  irom  the  apostles,  to  whom 
they  returned  after  they  had  executed  their 
commission,  so  that,  in  short,  this  ofiSce, 
being  extraordinary,  expired  with  the 
apostles. 

The  title  of  Evangelists  is  now  more 
particularly  given  to  those  four  holy  per- 
sons who  wrote  the  history  of  our  Saviour. 

EVENS.  Eves,  or  vigils.  The  nights 
or  evenings  before  certain  holy-days  of  the 
Church  (See  Vigils). 

EVEN-SONG  (See  Liturgy).  Evening 
prayer,  which  is  appointed  to  be  sung  or 
said.  The  office  of  even-song,  or  evening 
prayer,  is  a  judicious  abridgment  of  the 
offices  of  vespers  (i.e.  even-song)  and  com- 
pline, as  used  in  our  Church  before  the 
Reformation ;  and  it  appears  that  the  re- 
visers of  our  offices  formed  the  introduction 
to  evening  prayer  from  those  parts  of  both 
vespers  and  compline  which  seemed  best 
suited  to  this  place,  and  which  presented 
uniformity  with  the  introduction  to  morning 
prayer. 

Even-song  occurs  in  the  table  of  Proper 
Lessons  for  Sundays  and  Holy-days,  and 
Proper  Psalms.  It  is  in  fact  the  same  as 
the  old  word  vesjjcr  ;  and  only  differs  from 
the  other  authorised  expression,  evening 
prayer,  in  having  more  special  reference  to 
the  psalms  and  hymns,  and  the  anthem, 
those  holy  songs  which  make  up  so  large  a 
portion  of  the  service. 

EXALTATION  OF  THE  CROSS.  A 
festival  of  the  Greek  and  Roman  Churches 
observed  on  the  14th  of  December.  It  is 
founded  on  the  following  legend : 

In  the  reign  of  Heraclius  (a.d.  614)  Chos- 
roes,  king  of  Persia,  sacked  Jerusalem,  and, 
together  with  other  plunder,  carried  off  that 
part  of  the  cross  left  there  in  memory  of  our 
Saviour,  by  the  empress  Helena,  which  Chos- 
roes  sent  into  Persia.  After  many  battles, 
in  which  the  Persian  was  always  defeated, 
Heraclius  had  the  good  fortune  to  recover 
the  cross.     This  prince  carried  it  to  Jeru- 


EXAMINATION 

salem  himself;  and,  laying  aside  his  impe- 
rial ornaments,  marched  with  it  on  his- 
shoulders  to  the  top  of  Mount  Calvary, 
from  whence  it  had  been  taken.  The  me- 
mory of  this  action  was  perpetuated  by  the- 
festival  of  the  re-establishment,  or  (as  it  is- 
now  called)  the  exaltation  of  the  cross. 

The  latter  name  was  given  to  this  festi- 
val, because  on  this  day  they  exalted  or 
set  up  the  cross  in  the  great  church  at 
Constantinople,  in  order  to  show  it  to  the 
people. 

EXAMINATION  FOR  ORDERS. 
When  a  person  presents  himself  for  ordi- 
nation, there  are,  besides  the  vocation  and 
voluntary  offer  of  the  candidate,  two  pre- 
liminaries, (1)  the  testimony  of  the  people, 
and  (2)  an  examination  by  the  bishop  and 
clergy.  The  testimony  of  the  people  was 
always  required,  and  in  the  Primitive 
Church  an  firiKJipv^is,  or  praBdicatio,  a  pro- 
clamation, that  is  of  the  candidates,  was 
made  before  the  congregation  (St.  Cyprian, 
Epist.  Ixviii.  3 ;  Lampridius,  c.  xlv. ;  Coun- 
cil of  Chalcedon,  c.  21).  At  the  present 
time  the  "Si  quis"  has  to  be  published 
in  the  parish  where  the  candidate  resides 
(See  Si  quis).  An  examination  also  was 
from  early  time  deemed  requisite,  and  is 
referred  to  by  St.  Chrysostom,  St.  Cyprian, 
Gregory  I.,  and  many  others ;  besides  being 
ordered  by  several  councils.  Justinian  speaks 
of  the  scandal  which  had  arisen  from  clerks 
having  been  ordained  without  due  exami- 
nation (Novell.  137,  c.  1),  and  in  order 
to  make  the  examination  more  effective, 
Gregory  the  Great  advised  a  bishop  to 
associate  with  himself  "  graves  expertosque 
viros"  (JEp.  iii.  49).  This  became  the 
practice  throughout  the  V7est,  and  was 
observed  by  the  English  Church  (Councils 
of  Glovesho,  747,  c.  vi. ;  Ceakhytlie,  787,  c. 
yi. ;  Oxford,  1222 ;  Lambeth,  1330 ;  London, 
1557).  To  ensure  that  such  examination, 
took  place,  and  to  prevent  uncanonical  in- 
trusions, bishops  are  forbidden  to  ordain 
clerks  out  of  their  own  diocese,  \mless  with 
the  consent  and  letters  dimissory  of  the 
diocesan  (See  Dimissory  Letters). 

By  our  Canon  35  it  is  ordered:  "The 
bishop,  before  he  admit  any  person  to- 
holy  orders,  shall  diligently  examine  him, 
in  the  presence  of  those  ministers  that 
shall  assist  him  at  the  imposition  of  hands ; 
and  if  the  bishop  have  any  lawful  im- 
pediment, he  shall  cause  the  said  ministers- 
carefully  to  examine  every  such  person  so 
to  be  ordered.  .  .  .  And  if  any  bishop  or 
suffragan  shall  admit  any  to  sacred  orders 
who  is  not  so  examined,  and  qualified  as 
before  we  have  ordained  [viz.  in  Canon  34], 
the  archbishop  of  his  province,  having 
notice  thereof,  and  being  assisted  therein 
by  one  bishop,  shall  suspend  the  said  bishop- 


EXAMINATION 

or  sufFiagan  from  making  either  deacons  or 
priests  for  the  space  of  two  years." 

EXAMINATION  BEFORE  INSTI- 
TUTION. In  the  first  settlement  of  the 
Church  of  England,  the  bishops  had  their 
several  dioceses  under  their  own  immediate 
care,  and  that  of  the  clergy  living  in  a 
community  with  them,  whom  they  sent 
abroad  to  several  parts  of  their  dioceses, 
as  they  saw  occasion  to  employ  them ;  but 
by  degrees  they  found  it  necessary  to 
place  presbyters  within  such  a  compass, 
that  they  might  attend  upon  the  service 
of  Grod  amongst  the  inhabitants.  These 
precincts,  which  are  since  caUed  parishes, 
were  at  first  much  larger ;  and  when  lords 
of  manors  were  inclined  to  build  churches 
for  their  own  convenience,  they  foimd  it 
necessary  to  make  some  endowments,  to 
oblige  those  who  oiBciated  in  their  churches 
to  a  diligent  attendance:  upon  this,  the 
several  bishops  were  very  well  content  to 
let  those  patrons  have  the  nomination  of 
persons  to  those  churches,  provided  they 
were  satisfied  of  the  fitness  of  those  per- 
sons, and  that  it  were  not  deferred  beyond 
such  a  limited  time.  So  that  the  right  of 
patronage  is  really  but  a  limited  trust; 
and  the  bishops  are  still  in  law  the  judges 
of  the  fitness  of  the  persons  to  be  employed 
in  the  several  parts  of  their  dioceses.  The 
patrons  never  had  the  absolute  disposal  of 
their  benefices  upon  their  own  terms;  but 
if  they  did  not  present  fit  persons  within 
the  hmited  time,  the  care  of  the  places 
returned  to  the  bishop,  who  was  then  bound 
to  provide  for  them. 

By  the  statute  ArticuU  cleri,  9  Edward 
II.  s.  1,  c.  13,  it  is  enacted  as  follows : — 
"  It  is  desired  that  spiritual  persons,  whom 
our  lord  the  king  doth  present  unto  benefices 
of  the  Church  (if  the  bishop  will  not  admit 
them,  either  for  lack  of  learning,  or  for  other 
cause  reasonable),  may  not  be  under  the 
examination  of  lay  persons  in  the  cases 
aforesaid,  as  it  is  now  attempted,  contrary 
to  the  decrees  canonical;  but  that  they 
may  sue  unto  a  spiritual  judge  for  re- 
medy, as  right  shall  require."  The  an- 
swer is — Of  the  ability  of  a  person  presented 
tmto  a  benefice  of  the  Church,  the  ex- 
amination belongeth  to  a  spiritual  judge; 
so  it  hath  been  used  heretofore,  and  shall 
be  hereafter." 

"  Of  the  ability  of  a  person  presented " 
— De  idoneitate  personal :  so  that  it  is  re- 
quired by  law,  that  the  person  presented 
be  idonea  persona ;  for  so  are  the  words 
of  the  king's  writ,  prxsentare  idoneam  per- 
sonam. And  this  idoneitas  consists  in 
divers  expressions  against  persons  pre- 
sented : — 1 .  Concerning  the  person,  as  if 
he  be  under  age  or  a  layman.  2.  Con- 
cerning his   conversation,  as  if  he  be  cri- 


EXAMINATION  £37 

minous.  3.  Concerning  his  inability  to 
discharge  his  pastoral  duty,  as  if  he  bo 
unlearned,  and  not  able  to  feed  his  flock 
with  spiritual  food.  And  the  examination 
of  the  ability  and  sufSciency  of  the  person 
presented  belongs  to  the  bishop,  who  is 
the  ecclesiastical  judge ;  and  in  this  ex- 
amination he  is  a  judge,  and  not  a  mini- 
ster, and  may  and  ought  to  refuse  the 
person  presented,  if  he  be  not  idonea  per- 
sona. 

"The  examination  belongs  to  a  spiri- 
tual judge ; "  and  yet  in  some  cases,  not- 
withstanding this  statute,  idoneitas  persona: 
shall  be  tried  by  the  country,  or  else  there 
should  be  a  failure  of  justice,  which  the 
law  will  not  suffer;  as  if  the  inability  or 
insufSciency  be  alleged  in  a  man  that  is 
dead,  this  case  is  out  of  the  statute;  for 
in  such  case  the  bishop  cannot  examine 
him ;  and,  consequently,  though  the  matter 
be  spiritual,  yet  shall  it  be  tried  by  a 
jury;  and  the  court,  being  assisted  by 
learned  men  in  that  profession,  may  in- 
struct the  jury  as  well  of  the  ecclesiastical 
law  in  that  case,  as  they  usually  do  of  the 
common  law. 

By  a  constitution  of  Archbishop  Lang- 
ton  : — "  We  do  enjoin,  that  if  any  one 
be  canonically  presented  to  a  church,  and 
there  be  no  opposition,  the  bishop  shall  not 
delay  to  admit  him  longer  than  two  months, 
provided  he  be  sufBcient." 

But  by  Canon  95 — "Albeit  by  former 
constitutions  of  the  Church  of  England, 
every  bishop  hath  had  two  months'  space 
to  inquire  and  inform  himself  of  the  suffi- 
ciency and  qualities  of  every  minister  after 
he  hath  been  presented  unto  him  to  be 
instituted  into  any  benefice,  yet  for  the 
avoiding  of  some  inconveniences,  we  do 
now  abridge  and  reduce  the  said  two 
months  unto  eight  and  twenty  days  onl3''. 
In  respect  of  which  abridgment  we  do 
ordain  and  appoint  that  no  double  quan-el 
(see  Duplex  qittreUx)  shall  hereafter  be 
granted  out  of  any  of  the  archbishops' 
courts,  at  the  suit  of  any  minister  what- 
soever, except  he  shall  first  take  his 
personal  oath,  that  the  said  eight  and 
twenty  days  at  the  least  are  expired  after 
he  first  tendered  his  presentation  to  the 
bishop,  and  that  he  refused  to  grant  him 
institution  thereupon;  or  shall  enter  into 
bond  with  sufBcient  sureties  to  prove  the 
same  to  be  true ;  under  pain  of  suspension 
of  the  granter  thereof  from  the  execution 
of  his  office  for  half-a-year  toties  gitoties, 
to  be  denounced  by  the  said  archbishop, 
and  nullity  of  the  double  quarrel  aforesaid 
so  unduly  procured,  to  all  intents  and 
purposes  whatsoever.  Always  provided, 
that  within  the  said  eight  and  twenty 
days,   the   bishop    shall  not  institute  any 


338 


EXAMINATION 


other  to  the  prejudice  of  the  said  party 
before  presented,  sub  poena  nulUtatis. 

"To  inquire  and  inform  himself." — In 
answer  to  an  objection  made,  that  the 
bishop  ought  to  receive  the  clerk  of  him 
that  comes  first,  otherwise  he  is  a  dis- 
turber, Hobart  saith,  the  law  is  contrary : 
for  as  he  may  take  competent  time  to 
examine  the  sufficiency  and  fitness  of  a 
clerk,  so  he  may  give  convenient  time  to 
persons  interested,  to  take  knowledge  of 
the  avoidance  (even  in  case  of  death,  and 
where  notice  is  to  be  taken  and  not  given), 
to  present  their  clerks  to  it. 

Canon  39.  "No  bishop  shall  institute 
any  to  a  benefice,  who  hath  been  ordained 
by  any  other  bishop,  except  he  first  show 
unto  him  his  letters  of  orders;  and  bring 
him  a  sufficient  testimony  of  his  former 
good  life  and  behaviour,  if  the  bishop 
shall  require  it ;  and,  lastly,  shall  appear 
upon  due  examination  to  be  worthy  of  his 
ministry." 

"  Except  he  first  show  unto  him  his 
letters  of  orders."— And  by  the  13  &  14 
Charles  II.  c.  4,  no  person  shall  be  ca- 
pable to  be  admitted  to  any  parsonage, 
vicarage,  benefice,  or  other  ecclesiastical 
promotion  or  dignity  whatsoever,  before 
such  time  as  he  shall  be  ordained  priest, 
and  bring  a  sufficient  testimony  ot  his 
former  good  life  and  behaviour.  By  the 
ancient  laws  of  the  Church,  and  particu- 
larly of  the  Church  of  England,  the  four 
things  in  which  the  bishop  was  to  have 
full  satisfaction  in  order  to  institution, 
were  age,  learning,  behaviour,  and  orders. 
And  there  is  scarce  any  one  thing  which 
the  ancient  canons  of  the  Church  more 
peremptorily  forbid,  than  the  admitting 
clergymen  of  one  diocese  to  exercise  their 
function  in  another,  without  first  exhibiting 
the  letters  testimonial  and  commendatory 
of  the  bishop  by  whom  they  were  or- 
dained ;  and  the  constitutions  of  the  Arch- 
bishops Reynolds  and  Arundel  show  that 
the  same  was  the  known  law  of  the  English 
Church,  to  wit,  that  none  should  be  ad- 
mitted to  officiate  (not  so  much  as  a  chap- 
lain or  curate)  in  any  diocese  in  which  he 
was  not  bom  or  ordained,  unless  he  bring 
with  him  his  letters  of  orders,  and  letters 
commendatory  of  his  diocesan. 

And,  lastly,  "  shall  appear,  upon  due 
examination,  to  he  worthy  of  his  ministry." 
— As  to  the  matter  of  learning,  it  hath 
been  particularly  allowed,  not  only  by  the 
courts  of  the  King's  Bench  and  Common 
Pleas,  hut  also  by  the  High  Court  of  Par- 
liament, that  the  ordinary  is  not  account- 
able to  any  temporal  court,  for  the  mea- 
sures he  takes  or  the  rules  by  which  he 
proceeds,  in  examining  and  judging  (only 
he  must  examine  in  convenient  time,  and 


EXAECH 

refuse  in  convenient  time)  ;  and  that  the 
clerk's  having  been  ordained  (and  so  presumed 
to  be  of  good  abilities)  doth  not  take  away  or 
diminish  the  right  which  the  statute  above 
recited  doth  give  to  the  bishop  to  whom  the 
presentation  is  made  to  examine  and  judge 
(Burn  and  Phillimore,  Ecc.  Law,  411). 

But  these  general  enactments  and  dicta 
as  to  the  bishop's  absolute  power  of  judging 
of  qualifications  and  demanding  testimonials 
have  been  a  good  deal  qualified  by  modern 
decisions,  and  it  is  not  very  easy  to  define  the 
actual  limits.  It  was  decided  in  Bishop  of 
Exeter  v.  Marshall,  3  L.  E.,  H.  L.,  17,  that 
the  bishop  cannot  reject  a  presentee  for 
mere  want  of  testimonials;  and  that  he 
must  state  in  what  respect  he  finds  him  on 
examiriation  to  be  unfit.  It  is  very  doubt- 
ful therefore  whether  a  mere  return  of 
minus  sufficiens  in  Uteraturd  would  be 
sufficient  now,  though  the  King's  Bench 
under  Lord  Ellenborough  treated  it  so  (15 
East,  117)  in  the  matter  of  Povah,  who  was 
presented  as  a  lecturer  in  the  City,  and 
had  to  be  licensed  and  approved  by  the 
bishop ;  and  he  speaks  of  a  previous  case 
of  a  living,  viz.,  Sele  v.  Bishop  of  Exeter 
(Shower's  Par.  Cas.  88) ;  and  the  whole  of 
his  reasoning  goes  to  the  legal  impossihihty 
of  anybody  but  the  bishop  trying  whether 
a  presentee  is  idoneus  or  not,  at  least  in 
literature.  Probably  the  true  solution  is 
that  the  bishop's  examination  must  be 
accepted  as  conclusive  on  the  candidate's 
degree  of  knowledge ;  hut  that  even  the 
civil  court  on  a  quare  impedit  action  will 
try  whether  it  is  a  kind  of  knowledge  which 
ought  to  be  required.  The  Welsh  bishops 
are  authorised  but  not  required  by  11  &  12 
Vict.  c.  106,  'to  require  a  knowledge  of 
"Welsh  from  presentees  to  benefices  in  their 
dioceses. 

The  more  recent  cases  have  all  been  on 
examination  for  what  may  shortly  be  called 
heresy,  or  maintaining  doctrines  or  practising 
ritual  contrary  to  the  Prayer  Book  or  Arti- 
cles. The  Gorham  case  throughout  (Brod- 
rick  &  Fremantle's  Ecc.  Judgments),  and 
the  late  quare  impedit  case  of  Heywood  v. 
Bishop  of  Manchester  in  1884  have  put  an 
end  to  any  doubt  about  the  bishop's  right 
to  examine  on  such  points.     [Gr.] 

EXAECH.  Literally  "one  who  leads." 
Originally  applied  to  those  prelates  who 
presided  over  the  dioceses  which  were 
formed  on  the  lines  of  the  civil  dioceses  of 
the  Eoman  Empire.  These  included,  each 
of  them,  several  provinces,  and  the  metro- 
politans of  the  provinces  were  subordinate  1o 
the  exarchs.  In  later  times  the  name  was 
applied  to  an  officer  appointed  by  the  Patri- 
arch of  Constantinople,  whose  business  it  is 
to  visit  the  provinces  allotted  to  him,  in 
order  to  inform  himself  of  the  lives  and 


EXCOMMUNICA.TION 

manners  of  the  clergy ;  take  cognizance  of 
ecclesiastical  causes ;  the  manner  of  celebra- 
ting Divine  service ;  the  administration  of 
the  sacraments,  particularly  confession ;  the 
observance  of  the  canons;  monastic  disci- 
pline ;  affairs  of  marriages ;  divorces,  &c. 

Bingham  (bk.  ii.  c.  17)  speaks  of  the  title 
■"  exarchs  of  the  diocese  "  as  being  synony- 
mous in  primitive  times  with  that  of  patri- 
archs: but  it  would  seem  that  the  title 
patriarch  was  reserved  for  the  heads  of  the 
most  important  dioceses — Neale's  Holy  E. 
CL,  Introd. ;  Diet.  Chnst.  Ant  637.     [H.] 

EXCOMMUNICATION  is  an  ecclesias- 
tical censure,  whereby  the  person  against 
whom  it  is  pronounced  is  for  the  time  cast 
out  of  the  commrmion  of  the  Church.  In 
the  earliest  ages  of  the  Church,  excom- 
munication appears  to  have  been  of  one 
iind  only,  but  afterwards  it  was  of  two 
kinds,  the  lesser  and  the  greater :  the  lesser 
■excommunication  was  the  depriving  the 
offender  of  the  use  of  the  sacraments  and 
Divioe  worship;  and  this  sentence  was 
passed  by  judges  ecclesiastical  on  such 
persons  as  were  guilty  of  obstinacy  or  dis- 
obedience, in  not  appearing  upon  a  citation, 
■or  not  submitting  to  penance,  or  other  in- 
iunctions  of  the  court. 

The  greater  excommunication  was  that 
whereby  men  were  totally  expelled  the 
■Church,  and  •  deprived  of  the  society  and 
■conversation  of  the  faithful.  To  these  were 
added  the  "anathema,"  the  greatest  curse 
that  could  be  laid  upon  man.  To  this  latter 
apparently  the  ofSce  in  the  Sarum  pontifical 
refers. — Maskell,  Mon.  Rit.  Ecc.  Any.  ii. 
clxv.  seq. 

After  the  Eeformation  there  seems  to 
have  been  considerable  irregularity  with 
legard  to  excommunications,  for  Archbishop 
Tenison  req^uired  his  suffragan  to  see  that 
■"  none  be  instrumental  in  pronouncing 
sentences  of  excommunication  and  absolu- 
tion, without  such  solemnity  as  that  great 
^nd  weighty  matter  requires."  Archbishop 
Williams  calls  it  that  "  rusty  sword  of  the 
Church,"  yet  in  1681  it  was  directed  against 
■"  Popish  recusants,"  and  the  year  after 
against  Dissenters. — Blunt's  Diet.  Doct. 
Tlieol. 

[Excommunication  has  been  considerably 
modified  and  reduced  to  such  small  di- 
mensions by  various  modern  Acts  that  one 
:seldom  hears  of  it  now.  The  withdrawal  of 
all  the  matrimonial  and  other  partly  civil 
matters  from  the  ecclesiastical  courts,  and 
-the  substitution  of  a  summary  process  for 
■contempt  of  monitions,  suspensions,  and 
other  orders,  have  almost  extinguished  this 
once  formidable  weapon  of  the  Church,  but 
not  entirely.  The  extent  to  which  it 
xemains  is  substantially  defined  yet  by  the 
Act   53   Geo.  III.   c.   127,   except   in   the 


EXCOMMUNICATION 


339 


matters  altogether  withdrawn  from  the 
ecclesiastical  courts.  That  Act  had  already 
abolished  it  as  a  means  of  enforcing  any 
civil  process  therefrom,  and  substituted 
signification  for  contempt,  both  io  that  and 
other  cases  of  disobedience  to  lawful  orders 
or  decrees,  as  well  final  as  interlocutory, 
which  is  to  be  followed  by  imprisonment 
until  the  party  either  submits  or  is  dis- 
charged by  the  court  under  3  &  4  Vict. 
c.  93,  by  consent  of  the  other  side ;  or,  it 
has  been  held,  where  the  object  of  the  suit 
has  been  gained  by  some  other  decree,  as  in 
Mr.  Green's  case  after  he  was  deprived 
while  in  prison  for  contempt.  The  former 
Act  (ss.  2  &  3)  however  in  a  complicated 
way  reserved  whatever  power  the  ecclesias- 
tical courts  had  before  of  excommunicating 
in  definitive  (or  final)  sentences  as  punish- 
ment for  ecclesiastical  offences,  and  also  that 
such  sentences  may  be  followed  by  such 
imprisonment  up  to  six  months  as  the 
court  directs,  signifying  the  same  into 
chancery  as  usual,  but  with  power  for  the 
court  to  absolve  at  any  earher  time  at  its 
discretion. 

It  seems  that  excommunication  of  this 
kind  may  be  pardoned  by  the  Queen, 
though  contempt  by  disobedience  cannot, 
any  more  than  disobedience  to  any  other 
court.  2  &  3  Will.  TV.  c.  93  extended  the 
powers  of  signifying  and  imprisoning  for 
contempt.  Therefore,  although  matrimonial 
suits,  for  nulUty  of  marriage  and  the  hke, 
are  withdrawn  from  the  ecclesiastical  courts 
by  the  Divorce  Act,  1857,  nothing  seems  to 
have  taken  away  their  power  to  excom- 
municate— and  even  to  order  penance — for 
living  in  incest,  adultery,  or  fornication. 
Sir  E.  Phillimore,  while  Chancellor  of 
Chichester  in  1856,  in  a  very  gross  case  of 
incest,  abstained  from  ordering  either 
penance  or  excommunication  at  once,  but 
monished  the  parties  to  live  apart  and  to 
cease  such  intercourse,  and  said  that  ex- 
communication would  follow  if  they  did  not 
(see  his  Ecc.  Law,  1375).  As  the  man  was 
not  a  clergyman  it  was  not  a  clerical 
offence,  and  therefore  remained  in  the  juris- 
diction of  the  Diocesan  Court  notmth- 
standing  the  Clergy  Discipline  Act,  IB'iO. 
It  is  quite  settled  that  the  ecclesiastical 
coiuts  must  certify  the  reason  for  an  ex- 
communication, and  that  they,  and  the 
bishops  personally,  while  they  could  ex- 
communicate, might  be  ordered  by  the 
superior  civil  courts  to  absolve  the  person 
if  the  reason  was  insufScient.  A  judgment 
of  Lord  Eldon's  to  that  effect  is  cited  in  the 
Ecclesiastical  Courts  Keport,  i.  167,  besides 
several  others,  in  dealing  -uith  the  question 
of  the  supremacy. 

Several  of  the  canons  prescribe  excom- 
munication, and  "  ipso  facto  excommunica- 

z  2 


310 


EXEAT 


tion,''  for  teaching  or  denying  or  doing 
various  things ;  but  the  canons  propria 
vigore  could  give  no  such  jurisdiction,  even 
over  the  clergy  (see  Canons').  And  it  may 
he  mentioned,  that  the  phrase  "  ipso  facto 
excommunicated "  was  never  allowed  to 
mean  "  without  a  judicial  sentence,"  which 
must  be  certified  as  aforesaid  to  have  any 
civil  effect.  It  is  quite  certain  now  that 
nobody  can  be  punished  for  maintaming  or 
doing  anything  merely  contrary  to  the 
Canons  and  not  to  the  Prayer  Book  or 
Articles,  except  so  far  as  the  Canons  only 
repeat  the  older  "  King's  ecclesiastical  law  " ; 
which  on  questions  of  doctrine  they  do  not. 
The  only  consequences  of  excommunication 
now,  when  lawful,  are  possible  imprisonment 
under  the  Act  of  Geo.  III.,  and  liability  to 
be  refused  the  Communion  and  burial  by  a 
clergyman.  It  is  said  that  under  old  law, 
if  an  excommunicated  clergyman  officiates 
in  church  he  shall  be  deprived,  but  the 
lawfulness  of  such  excommunication  would 
have  to  be  examined.]     [Gr.] 

EXEAT.  The  permission  given  by  the 
authorities  in  a  college,  to  persons  in  statu 
pupillari,  to  leave  their  college  residence 
for  a  time. 

EXEDR.iE,  lit.  covered  walks  or  spaces 
in  front  of  a  house ;  but  in  ecclesiastical 
antiquity  it  is  the  general  name  of  such 
buildings  as  were  distinct  from  the  main 
body  of  the  churches,  and  yet  within  the 
bounds  of  the  church,  taken  in  its  largest 
sense.  Thus  Eusehius,  speaking  of  the 
church  of  Paulinus  at  Tyre,  says,  "  When 
that  curious  artist  had  firdshed  his  famous 
structure  within,  he  then  set  himself  about 
the  exedrss,  or  buildings  that  joined  one  to 
another  by  the  sides  of  the  church  "  (Euse- 
bius,  lib.  X.  c.  4).  Among  the  exedrse,  the 
chief  was  the  haptistery,  or  place  of  baptism. 
Also  the  two  vestries,  or  sacristies,  as  we 
should  call  them,  stUl  found  in  aU  Oriental 
churches ;  viz.,  the  Diaconicum,  wherein 
the  sacred  utensils,  &c.,  were  kept ;  and  the 
Prothesis,  where  the  side-table  stood,  on 
which  the  elements  before  consecration  were 
placed. 

EXEGESIS  (i^Tjyria-is).  An  exposition  or 
explanation.  By  theological  writers  it  is 
used  to  comprehend  not  only  the  explanation 
of  Scripture,  but  also  of  the  history  and 
establishment  of  the  Canon  of  Scripture, 
and  sacred  philosophy  generally. 

EXEMPTION,  in  the  ecclesiastical  sense 
of  the  word,  means  a  privilege  given  by 
the  Pope  to  the  clergy,  and  sometimes  to 
the  laity,  to  exempt  or  free  them  from  the 
juiisdiction  of  their  respective  ordinaries. 

When  monasteries  began  to  be  erected, 
and  governed  by  abbots  of  great  quality, 
merit,  and  figure,  these  men,  to  cover  their 
ambition,  and  to  discharge  themselves  from 


EXHORTATION 

the  subjection  which  they  owed  to  the 
bishops,  procured  grants  from  the  court  of 
Kome,  to  be  received  under  the  protection 
of  St.  Peter,  and  to  be  put  immediately 
under  subjection  to  the  Pope.  This  request 
being  for  the  interest  of  the  court  of  Eome, 
inasmuch  as  it  contributed  greatly  to  the 
advancement  of  the  papal  authority,  and  aU 
the  monasteries  were  presently  exempted. 
The  chapters  also  of  cathedral  churches 
obtained  exemptions  upon  the  same  score. 

St.  Bernard,  who  lived  at  the  time  when 
this  invention  was  first  put  in  practice, 
took  the  freedom  to  tell  Pope  Eugenius  HI. 
that  it  was  no  better  than  an  abuse,  and 
that  it  was  by  no  means  defensible,  that 
an  abbot  should  withdraw  himself  from  the 
obedience  due  to  his  bishop;  that  the 
Church  militant  ought  to  be  governed  by 
the  precedent  of  the  Church  triumphant,  in 
which  no  angel  ever  said,  "  I  will  not  be 
under  the  jurisdiction  of  an  archangel." 

In  after  ages  this  abuse  was  carried  so 
far,  that,  for  a  small  charge,  private  priests 
procured  exemption  from  the  jm-isdiction 
of  their  bishop.  The  Council  of  Trent 
made  a  small  reformation  in  this  matter, 
by  abolishing  the  exemption  of  particular 
priests  and  friars,  not  living  in  cloisters, 
and  that  of  chapters  in  criminal  causes. — 
Sarpi's  Council  of  Trent. 

EXHORTATION.  By  this  general  name, 
the  addresses,  or  short  homilies,  of  the 
minister  to  the  people  are  called.  The 
ancient  Church  had  no  such  exhortations ; 
and  they  were  introducedjbecause  of  the  great 
neglect  of  communion  which  had  sprung  up 
in  the  middle  ages,  and  the  irreverence  which 
was  displayed  by  the  extreme  reformers 
respecting  it.  The  necessity  of  such  exhor- 
tations was  felt  long  before  the  Reformation. 
A  long  "  exhortation  before  communion  "  is 
to  be  found  in  the  Harleian  MS.  (2383)  in 
the  British  Museum.  It  begins :  "  Good  men 
and  women,  y  charge  you  by  the  auctoryte 
of  holy  Churche,  that  no  man  nother  wo- 
man that  this  day  proposyth  here  to  be 
comenyd  (communicated)  that  he  go  note 
to  Godds  bord,  lase  than  he  byleue  stedfast- 
lyeh,  that  the  sacrament  that  he  ys  avysyd 
here  to  rescue,  that  yt  ys  Godds  body 
flesche  and  blode,  yn  the  fonne  of  bred ;  and 
that  (which)  he  recej^vythe  afterwards,  ys 
no  thyng  ells  but  wyne  and  water,  for  to 
dense  your  mowthys  of  the  holy  sacra- 
niant " ;  and  it  goes  on  to  exhort  the  hearers 
to  chastity  and  Christian  consistency  of  life 
and  due  preparation. — MaskeU,  iii.  408. 

The  service  of  the  Church  of  England  is 
distinguished  by  the  number  and  fitness  ot 
its  exhortations.  These  are :  one  at  the 
beginning  of  Morning  and  Evening  Prayer  ; 
two  in  the  Communion  Service,  when  notice 
is  given  of  the  holj'  communion ;  another 


EXODUS 

at  tlie  time  of  celebration.  Five  in  the 
Baptismal  Service ;  two  in  the  office  for 
receiving  those  into  the  Chm-cli  who  have 
been  privately  baptized ;  and  five  in  the 
Baptism  of  those  of  Riper  Years ;  one  in  the 
Confirmation  Office ;  two  in  the  Solemniza- 
tion of  Matrimony ;  two  in  the  Visitation 
of  the  Sick ;  one  in  the  Churching  Service ; 
two  in  the  Commination  Service;  besides 
those  in  the  Ordination  Service.  These 
may  be  considered  as  so  many  sermons  of 
the  Church,  which  assert  her  doctrines,  and 
fully  show  what  she  expects  from  the  faith 
and  practice  of  her  children.     [H.] 

EXODUS  (From  the  Greek  c|o8or, 
3oing  out).  The  term  generally  applied  to 
the  departure  of  the  Israelites  from  Egypt. 
The  second  book  of  the  Bible  is  so  called, 
because  it  is  chiefly  occupied  with  the  ao- 
(jount  of  that  part  of  the  sacred  history.  It 
comprehends  the  transactions  of  145  years, 
from  the  death  of  Joseph  in  2369  B.C.  to 
the  building  of  the  Tabernacle  in  2114. 

EXORCISMS  (from  i^opKl^a,  to  conjure) 
were  certain  prayers  used  of  old  in  the 
Christian  churches  for  the  dispossessing  of 
devils.  This  custom  of  exorcism  is  as  ancient 
as  Christianity  itself,  being  practised  by  the 
apostles,  and  the  primitive  Church ;  and  the 
Christians  were  well  assured  of  the  preva- 
lency  of  their  prayers  upon  these  occasions. — 
Tertul.  Apol.  c.  23. 

Before  baptism  prayers  for  exorcism — the 
conjuring  forth  of  the  evil  spirit — were  always 
used.  Thus  in  an  old  "  form  of  the  Greater 
Excommunication,"  these  words  occur: — '■ 
"  Clerkes  seyh  that  a  childe  byfore  it  be 
cristned,  it  hath  a  wikked  spirit  dwelling  in 
the  soule.  The  wich  wikkede  spirit  is  con- 
jured, and  cast  out  thorough  prayers  of  the 
prest,  byfore  the  chirche  close  whance  it 
shal  be  cristned,"  &c. — Haskell,  iii.  310. 

In  the  form  of  baptism,  in  the  first  Prayer 
Book  of  Edward  VL,  it  was  ordered  thus : — 
"  Then  let  the  priest,  looking  upon  the 
children,  say,  'I  command  thee,  unclean 
spirit,  in  the  name  of  the  Father,  of  the 
Son,  and  of  the  Holy  Ghost,  that  thou 
came  out  and  depart  from  these  infants, 
whom  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ  hath  vouch- 
safed to  call  to  his  holy  baptism,  to  be 
made  members  of  his  body,  and  of  his  holy 
congregation  ;  therefore,  thou  cursed  spirit, 
remember  thy  sentence,  remember  thy 
judgment,  remember  the  day  to  be  at 
hand  wherein  thou  shalt  bum  in  fire  ever- 
lasting, prepared  for  thee  and  thy  angels ; 
and  presume  not  hereafter  to  exercise  any 
tyranny  towards  these  infants  whom  Christ 
hath  bought  viith  his  precious  blood,  and 
liy  this  his  holy  baptism  called  to  be  of  his 
flock  "  (See  Baptism). 

This  was  taken  from  ancient  uses,  but 
because,  in  process  of  time,  many  supersti- 


EXPIATION 


341 


tious  and  unwarrantable  practices  mixed 
with  this  ancient  rite,  especially  in  the 
Roman  Church,  our  Reformers  wisely 
thought  fit  to  lay  it  quite  aside,  and  to 
substitute  in  lieu  of  it  these  short  prayers, 
wherein  the  minister  and  the  congregation 
put  up  their  petitions  to  Almighty  God, 
that  the  child  may  be  delivered  from  the 
power  of  the  devil,  and  receive  all  the 
benefits  of  the  Divine  grace  and  protection, 
without  the  ancient  ceremony  attending 
it. 

Canon  72.  "  No  minister  shall,  without 
the  licence  of  the  bishop  of  the  diocese, 
under  his  hand  and  seal,  attempt,  upon  any 
pretence  whatsoever,  to  cast  out  any  devil 
or  devils,  under  pain  of  the  imputation  of 
imposture  or  cozenage,  and  deposition  from 
the  ministry." 

EXORCISTS  were  persons  apix)inted  in 
the  latter  end  of  the  third  century,  on  pur- 
pose to  take  care  of  such  as  were  demoniacs, 
or  possessed  with  evil  spirits.  In  the  first 
ages  of  Christianity  thei-e  were  many  persons 
who  are  represented  as  jxissessed  with  evil 
spirits,  and  exorcism  was  performed  by 
a  particular  set  of  men.  Afterwards  it 
was  judged  requisite  by  the  bishops  to 
appropriate  this  office  by  ordination.  They 
are  still  a  separate  order  in  the  Church  of 
Rome. — Tertul.  de  Idol.  c.  ii.;  Epiphan. 
Expos.  Fid.  c.  21 ;  Martene,  t.  i.  121. 

An  account  of  exorcising  the  evil  spirit 
is  given  by  Jer.  Tajdor,  who  adds,  "  From 
what  principle  it  comes  that  they  have 
made  exorcists  an  ecclesiastical  order  ;  and 
that  the  words  of  ordination  giving  them 
power  only  over  possessed  Christians  ...  we 
cannot  guess  at,  except  they  have  derived 
them  from  the  Jemsh  Cabbala." — Works, 
vol.  X.  238,  Hcber's  ed. 

EXPECTATION  AVKEK.  The  whole 
of  the  interval  between  Ascension  Day 
and  WhitrSunday  is  so  called,  because  at 
this  time  the  apostles  continued  in  earnest 
prayer  and  expectation  of  the  Comforter. 

EXPIATION.  A  religious  act,  by  which 
satisfaction  or  atonement  is  made  for  some 
crime,  the  guilt  removed,  and  the  obligation 
to  punish  cancelled  (Lev.  xv.  15). 

EXPIATION,  THE  GREAT  DAY  OF. 
An  annual  solemnity  of  the  Jews  observed 
upon  the  10th  day  of  the  month  Tisri, 
which  answers  to  our  September.  The 
Hebrews  call  itOeeper  (from  "1.33), "  pardon," 
because  the  sins  of  the  whole  people  were 
then  expiated  or  pardoned.  It  was  a  day 
of  rest,  and  strict  fasting,  and  on  which  all 
differences  were  put  away,  and  reconcilia- 
tions made. 

It  is  of  this  fast  we  are  to  understand 
that  passage  of  the  Acts,  where  St.  Luke 
says,  that  St.  Paul  comforted  those  who 
were  with  him  in  the  ship,  "  when  sailing 


312 


EXTEMPORE 


was  Lecome  dangerous,  because  the  fast  was 
already  past "  (Acts  xxvii.  9).     [H.] 

EXTEMPORE  PEBACHING.  Properly, 
preacMng  without  any  prejDaration.  This 
none  but  enthusiasts  uphold.  Unpre- 
meditated speech  was  promised  to  the 
apostles  in  their  peculiar  difficulties,  beyond 
human  resources  (St.  Luke  xxi.  14;  St. 
Matt.  X.  9);  but  this  does  not  imply  that 
under  ordinary  circumstances  ministers  need 
not  prepare  (See  1  Tim.  iv.  13).  In  its 
ordinary  meaning  the  term  refers  to  un- 
written  sermons  whether  previously  prepared 
or  not.  Though  the  sermons  in  the  early 
Christian  times  appear  to  have  been  ge- 
nerally written,  there  was  no  rule  on  the 
subject.  Origen  is  said  to  have  been  the 
first  who  preached  unwritten  sermons,  which 
were  taken  down  by  Taxyypa.<j>oi,  or  short- 
hand writers,  and  so  preserved.  But  this 
is  mentioned  as  proof  of  his  study  of  the 
Scriptures,  which  enabled  him  to  do  this, 
and  write  also  laborious  treatises  (Euseb. 
lib.  vi.  c.  36).  The  two  mightiest  preachers 
of  the  East  and  West,  SS.  Chrysostom  and 
Augustine,  used  both  methods.  The  former 
after  his  return  from  banishment  was 
forced  to  go  up  into  his  throne,  so  eager 
were  the  people  to  hear  him,  and  deliver 
an  "  extempore  "  discourse,  which  is  still 
extant  (Sermo  post  Beditum,  t.  ii.  p.  49), 
and  he  used  often  to  speak  his  panegyrics 
on  the  Martyrs  off-hand  without  hesitation. — 
Suidas,  voce  Joannes. 

St.  Augustine  also  often  preached  extem- 
pore, as  when  the  reader  had  read  another 
psalm  than  the  appointed  one,  he  preached 
upon  it,  instead  of  delivering  his  prepared 
address  (Possid.  Vit.  Aug.  c.  15).  The  care 
he  would  have  ail  take  in  their  sermons  is 
shown  in  his  essay  on  Christian  doctrine  (Bk. 
iv).  From  that  time  to  this,  the  comparative 
advantages  of  extempore  or  written  sermons 
have  been  a  matter  of  discussion.  In  some 
Churches  and  by  some  sects  the  latter  are 
forbidden,  but  the  Church  of  England  makes 
no  rule.  Archbishop  Seeker  sums  up :  "  After 
all,  every  man  (as  the  Apostle  saith  on  a 
different  occasion)  hath  his  proper  gift  of 
God,  one  after  this  manner,  another  after 
that.  Let  each  cultivate  his  own  and  no  one 
censure  or  despise  his  brother"  {Charges,  p. 
290).  It  was  necessary  to  speak  of  cultivat- 
ing :  for  there  had  got  "  an  ill  habit  of  speak- 
ing extempore,  and  a  loose  and  careless  way 
of  talking  in  the  pulpit  which  is  easy  to 
the  preacher,  and  plausible  to  less  judicious 
people "  (Stillingfleet,  Duties  of  Parochial 
Clergy,  p.  30).  The  great  lloman  orator  re- 
commends "much  writing  as  the  bestprepa- 
ration  to  good  speaking,"  (Caput  autem  est, 
quod  (ut  vere  dicam)  minime  facimus  (est 
enim  magni  laboris,  quem  plerique  fugimus), 
quam  plurimum  scribere"  (Cic.  de   Orat.). 


EXTEEME 

And  he  observes  that  should  the  speaker  use 
writing,  the  remainder  of  his  speech  (i.e.  the 
unwritten  part)  would  be  more  correct.  This 
is,  as  Seeker  observes,  "a  middle  way  used  by 
some  of  our  predecessors  (i.e.  Bishops  Burnet, 
Bull,  &c.),  which  duly  managed  would  be  the 
best"  (Charges, p. 287). — Bingham, bk. xiv. 
c.  4 ;  Moule's  Christ.  Orat.  of  First  Four 
Centuries ;  Cave,  Hist.  Lit.  i.  78 ;  Hull's 
Life,  by  Nelson,  p.  59;  Burnet's  £ast. 
Care.  c.  ix.     [H.] 

EXTRAVAGANTS  (See  Decretals). 
A  name  given  to  the  decretal  epistles  of 
the  popes  after  the  Clementines.  The  first 
Extravagants  are  those  of  John  XXIIL, 
successor  to  Clement  V. ;  they  were  so 
named  because,  at  first,  they  were  not 
digested,  nor  ranged  with  the  other  papal 
constitutions,  but  seemed  to  be,  as  it  were, 
detached  from  the  canou  law ;  and  they  re- 
tained the  same  name  when  they  were  after- 
wards inserted  into  the  body  of  the  canon 
law.  The  collection  of  decretals,  in  1483, 
were  called  the  Common  Fxtravagants,  not- 
withstanding they  were  likewise  embodied 
with  the  rest  of  the  canon  law. 

EXTREME  UNCTION.  The  apostles 
anointed  the  sick,  and  St.  James  recom- 
mends the  practice  (St.  Mark  vi.  13;  St. 
James  v.  14).  It  was  followed  in  every  part 
of  the  Church,  and  is  mentioned,  with  direc- 
tions, in  all  the  old  rituals,  but  it  soon  lost 
its  primitive  simplicity  (Martene,  tom.  iv. 
240 ;  for  history  of,  see  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  in 
2004).  In  the  Greek  Church  the  apostolic 
direction  is  still  literally  carried  out,  the 
priest  anointing  the  sick  as  well  as  praying 
for  them,  but  it  is  used  by  them  solely  for 
recovery  from  sickness,  as  the  following 
prayer  at  the  application  of  the  oil  clearly 
shows :  "  0  holy  Father,  the  physician  of 
our  souls  and  bodies,  who  didst  send  thine 
only-begotten  Son,  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ, 
to  heal  all  diseases,  and  to  deliver  us  from 
death,  heal  this  thy  servant  M.  from  the 
bodily  infirmity  under  which  he  now  labours, 
and  raise  him  up  by  the  grace  of  Christ." 
In  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549  there  was  no 
fonn  or  order  of  administering  extreme 
unction ;  but  it  did  not  altogether  "  prevent 
people  from  receiving  a  consolation  they  had 
been  accustomed  to  look  for  in  sickness." 
"  If  the  person  desire  to  be  anointed,  then 
shall  the  priest  anoint  him  on  the  forehead 
and  breast  only,  making  the  sign  of  the 
cross,  saying  thus — As  with  this  visible  oil 
thy  body  outwardly  is  anointed,"  &c.  This 
was  omitted  in  1552. — Maskell,  Mon.  Hit. 
Feci.  Aug.  i.  100. 

The  reason  of  the  omission  was  the  undue 
prominence  given  to  the  practice  by  the 
Roman  Church.  They  altered  it  into  a 
sacrament.  A  work  published  on  the  eve  of 
the  Reformation  asserts,  "  that  all  Christian 


EXTREME 

men  should  account  the  same  manner  of 
anointing,  among  the  other  sacraments  of 
the  Church,  forasmuch  as  it  is  a  visible 
sign  of  invisible  grace "  (^Institution  of  a 
Christian  Man). 

The  Roman  Council  of  Trent  asserts, 
"  The  holy  unction  of  the  sick  was  instituted 
by  our  Lord  Christ,  as  truly  and  properly 
a  sacrament  of  the  New  Testament,  as  is 
implied,  indeed,  in  St.  Mark;  but  com- 
mended and  declared  to  the  faithful  by 
James,  the  apostle  and  brother  of  the  Lord. 
"Is  any  sick  among  you?  Let  hitn  call 
for  the  elders  of  the  Church,  and  let  them 
pray  over  him,  anointing  him  with  oil  in 
the  name  of  the  Lord ;  and  the  prayer  of 
faith  shall  save  the  sick,  and  the  Lord 
shall  raise  him  up,  and  if  he  have  committed 
sins  they  shall  be  forgiven  him."  From 
which  words,  as  the  Church  hath  learned 
from  apostoHc  tradition  handed  down,  she 
teaches  the  matter,  form,  proper  minister, 
and  effect  of  this  wholesome  sacrament ;  for 
the  Church  has  understood  that  the  matter 
is  oil  blessed  by  the  bishop,  for  unction 
most  aptly  represents  the  grace  of  the  Holy 
Spirit  wherewith  the  soul  of  the  sick  man 
is  invisibly  anointed :  then  that  the  form 
consists  of  these  words,  "  By  this  anointing," 
&c. 

The  first  four  canons  of  that  council 
order  that,  "if  any  man  say  (1)  that  ex- 
treme unction  is  not  a  sacrament ;  (2)  that 
it  does  not  remit  sins ;  (3)  that  the  rite 
which  the  Eoman  Church  observes  may  be 
changed ;  (4)  that  the  elders  mentioned  by 
St.  James  were  not  duly  ordained  priests 
— let  him  be  accursed." 

"As  for  extreme  unction,"  says  Bishop 
Jeremy  Taylor,  "used  in  the  Church  of 
Rome,  since  it  is  used  when  the  man  is 
above  half  dead,  when  he  can  exercise  no 
act  of  understanding,  it  must  needs  be 
nothing;  for  no  rational  man  can  think  that 
any  ceremony  can  make  a  spiritual  change, 
■ivithout  a  spiritual  act  of  him  that  is  to  be 
changed ;  nor  work  by  way  of  nature,  or  by 
charms,  but  morally,  and  after  the  manner 
of  reasonable  creatures  ...  I  will  add  this 
only,  that  there  being  but  two  places  of 
Scripture  pretended  for  this  ceremony,  some 
chief  men  of  their  own  side  have  proclaimed 
those  two  invalid  as  to  the  institution  of  it : 
for  Suarez  says  (in  part  iii.  disp.  39,  sec.  1) 
that  the  unction  used  by  the  apostles  is  not 
the  same  with  what  is  used  in  the  Church  of 
Eome ;  and  that  it  cannot  be  plainly 
gathered  from  St.  James.  Cajetan  (cited  by 
Catherinus  annot.  Paris  1535,  p.  31,  &c.) 
afiBrms  that  it  did  belong  to  the  miracu- 
lous gift  of  healing,  not  to  a  sacrament" 
(Works,  vol.  iv.  p.  cocxxvii.  Ded.  to  Holy 
Dying). 

"  Now  that  this  miraculous  gift  (of  heal- 


FABIAN 


343 


ing  all  manner  of  diseases)  is  ceased,  there 
is  no  reason  why  the  more  ceremony  of 
anointing  with  oil  should  continue;  which 
yet  ia  still  used  in  the  Church  of  Rome, 
and  made  a  snorament ;  though  it  signify- 
nothing;  for  they  do  not  pretend  to  heal 
men  by  it,  nay,  they  pretend  the  contrary, 
because  they  never  use  it  but  in  extremity, 
and  where  they  look  upon  the  person  as  past 
recovery ;  and  if  they  do  not  think  so,  they 
would  not  use  it." — Abp.  TiUotson.    [H.] 

EZEKIEL,  THE  PROPHECY  OP.  A 
canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament. 
Ezekiel  was  the  son  of  Buzi,  of  the  house  of 
Aaron.  He  was  carried  captive  to  Babylon 
with  Jechoniah.  He  began  to  prophesy  in 
the  fifth  year  of  this  captivity,  which  is  the 
sera  by  which  he  reckons  in  all  his  prophe- 
cies. He  continued  to  prophesy  during 
twenty  years.  He  was  contemporary  with 
Jeremiah,  who  prophesied  at  the  same  time 
in  Judea.  He  foretold  many  events,  parti- 
cularly the  destruction  of  the  temple ;  the 
fatal  catastrophe  of  those  who  revolted  from 
Babylon  to  Egypt ;  and,  at  last,  the  happy 
return  of  the  Jews  into  their  own  land.  He 
distinctly  predicts  the  plagues  which  were 
to  fall  upon  the  enemies  of  the  Jews,  as  the 
Edomites,  Moabites,  Ammonites,  Egyptians, 
Assyrians,  and  Babylonians.  He  foretells 
the  coming  of  the  Messiah,  and  the  flourish- 
ing state  of  His  kingdom.  His  eighteenth 
chapter  contains  the  first  definite  announce- 
ment of  future  reward  and  punishment 
according  to  the  condition  in  which  a  man 
dies. — Du  Pin,  Canon  of  Scripture,  b.  1.  c. 
iii.  §  20.     See  Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible. 

EZRA,  BOOK  OF.  One  of  the  canonical 
books  of  Scripture. 

The  book  of  Ezra  was  written  in  the 
latter  end  of  the  author's  fife,  and  compre- 
hends the  transactions  of  about  eighty,  or, 
as  some  say,  a  hundred  years.  It  includes 
the  history  of  the  Jews  from  the  time  of 
Cyrus's  edict  for  their  return,  to  the 
twentieth  year  of  Artaierxes  Longimanus. 

Part  of  this  book  was  written  in  the 
Chaldee  language,  namely,  from  the  eighth 
verse  of  the  fourth  chapter  to  the  twenty- 
seventh  verse  of  the  seventh  chapter ;  all  the 
rest  was  written  in  Hebrew  (See  Smith's 
Diet,  of  Bible). 


F. 

FABIAN.  Bishop  and  Martyr.  He 
was  bishop  of  Rome  a.d.  236-250,  having 
been  elected,  though  a  layman,  in  conse- 
quence of  a  dove  alighting  on  his  head  while 
the  election  was  going  on  (Euseb.  H.  E. 
vi.  29).  He  is  mentioned  by  St.  Cyprian  as 
having  improved   the  organization  of  the 


344 


FACULTY 


Church,  having  ruled  her  with  integrity 
(Ep.  30).  He  sufl'ered  martyrdom  in  the 
Deoian  persecution,  and  a  tombstone  bearing 
his  name  was  recently  found  in  the  crypt  of 
an  ancient  cemetery  on  the  Appian  Way. 
Commemorated  in  our  calendar  Jan.  20. — 
Diet.  Christ.  Biog.  ii.  440.     [H.] 

FACULTY.  A  licence  from  the  consistory 
court  or  Chancellor  of  a  diocese  to  make 
alterations  in  or  addition  to  a  church,  or  to 
erect  monuments,  build  vaults  in  an  old 
churchyard,  with  the  right  of  the  man  and 
Ms  family  to  be  buried  there,  or  to  erect  and 
hold  pews  in  an  old  church ;  which  last  two 
are  never  granted  now,  except  in  con- 
sideration of  something  else  for  the  benefit 
of  the  parishioners.  The  expense  of  obtain- 
ing a  faculty  has  been  greatly  reduced  in 
most  if  not  all  dioceses  to  an  average  between 
£2  and  £3,  if  the  applicants  take  the  proper 
course  of  applying  themselves  to  the  dioce- 
san registrars,  without  the  intervention  of 
proctors  or  solicitors.  It  used  to  be  ten 
times  as  much,  even  without  any  opposi- 
tion. The  work  proposed  must  be  described 
as  circumstances  admit,  generally  by  plans 
and  specification  for  all  new  architectural 
works,  painted  windows,  organs  &c.  They 
are  generally,  if  not  always,  submitted 
first  to  the  bishop,  except  where  some  legal 
right  is  claimed;  though  strictly  speaking 
he  can  only  act  through  his  court,  and  the 
chancellor  may  feel  botmd  to  grant  a  faculty 
even  if  the  bishop  disapproves,  or  one  would 
probably  be  granted  by  the  provincial 
Court  on  appeal.  The  bishop  may  how- 
ever, and  often  does,  express  his  opinion 
to  the  chancellor,  or  to  the  petitioners, 
who  will  then  very  seldom  proceed  against 
it.  When  the  plans  go  to  the  chancellor  he 
has  to  exercise  a  judicial  discretion  as  to  their 
sufficiency  or  expediency,  and  it  has  been 
held  that  he  ought  to  regard  the  interests  of 
future  parishioners  if  he  sees  they  are  likely 
to  be  affected,  and  not  to  allow  alterations 
without  apparently  good  reasons,  whether 
there  is  any  opposition  or  not.  In  the  great 
majority  of  cases  there  is  none.  The  citation 
has  to  be  stuck  on  the  church  door  for 
a  fortnight,  as  a  notice  to  all  i>ersons  having 
any  interest,  to  object  if  they  think  fit :  i.e. 
to  all  persons  living  or  owning  land  or  houses 
in  the  parish,  and  no  others,  unless  they 
have  some  special  or  official  connexion  with 
the  church.  If  there  is  no  opposition,  the 
faculty  is  decreed  at  the  next  court.  If 
there  is  any,  the  cause  is  heard  by  the 
chancellor,  unless  the  parties  consent  to  his 
giving  judgment  on  affidavits  and  statements 
sent  to  him,  in  order  to  save  expense,  which 
judgment  is  read  by  himself  or  a  surrogate 
m  com-t.  The  parties  are  generally  glad  to 
adopt  that  course  except  in  cases  of  impor- 
tance enough  to  be  argued  by  counsel. 


FACULTY 

Care  ought  to  be  taken  in  aU  faculties 
that  the  architect's  specification,  and  the 
contract,  if  there  is  one  besides,  shall  con- 
tain a  clause  prohibiting  any  deviation  from 
the  sanctioned  plans  or  specification  without 
the  written  consent  of  the  incumbent  at  a 
specified  price,  and  also  of  the  chancellor. 
The  common  architect's  form  of  specifica- 
tion and  contract  legally  amounts  to  a  power 
to  the  architect  to  make  any  alteration  or 
additions  that  he  pleases  and  at  the  expense 
of  his  employers ;  and  clergymen  are  too 
often  unwilling  to  see  that  the  clause  above- 
mentioned  is  for  their  protection.  The 
legal  form  of  it,  and  of  others  for  the  same 
purpose,  is  given  in  Sir  Edmund  Beckett's 
Book  on  Building.  Some  such  provision  is 
necessary  to  allow  improvements  suggested 
as  the  work  goes  on,  and  yet  to  keep 
them  and  the  cost  of  them  imder  control. 
It  is  not  required  that  small  improvements 
should  be  submitted  to  the  chancellor.  The 
Chancellor  of  York  said,  in  a  case  of  Shades 
V.  Wrangham  (clerk)  in  1882,  "matters 
of  this  kind  must  be  governed  by  common 
sense,  or  church  restoration  would  become 
intolerable  to  the  clergy  and  impracti- 
cable," and  dismissed  the  complaint  against 
some  trifiing  deviations  as  frivolous  and 
vexatious.  In  deciding  on  opposed  as  weU 
as  unopposed  cases  the  chancellor  is  bound 
to  judge  as  well  as  he  can  whether  the 
proposed  works  will  be  a  real  improve- 
ment to  the  church,  and  not  merely  to 
regard  the  perhaps  temporary  wishes  and 
architectural  fancies  of  the  incumbent  or  the 
parishioners,  or  of  those  who  offer  to  pay  for 
the  work.  He  is  not  at  all  bound  by  the 
opinion  of  the  architect  who  has  made  the 
plans,  but  may  consult  any  other  competent 
person  or  his  own  knowledge.  Beans  of 
Arches  have  directed  and  made  inquiries  of 
their  own.  Where  the  building  is  in  an  un- 
safe condition,  of  course  that  is  a  substantial 
reason  for  sanctioning  any  apparently  satis- 
factory design  for  what  is  called  restoration, 
though  opinions  may  be  divided  about  it 
and  though  some  persons  prefer  interesting 
ruins  and  "historical  associations  "to  safe  and 
useful  churches.  Lord  Penzance  recalled 
a  faculty  which  had  been  granted  by  the 
Chancellor  of  London  for  what  were  objected 
to  as  merely  fanciful  alterations  of  a  church 
with  no  practical  advantage  or  evident  im- 
provement (See  Peek  v.  Trower,  1  P.  D.  21). 

In  some  dioceses  they  adhere  to  the  strict 
practice  laid  down  in  books  of  requiring 
security  for  completion  of  the  alterations 
proposed,  and  especially  of  a  total  rebuild- 
ing, for  fear  the  old  fabric  should  be  pulled 
down  and  the  new  one  not  rebuilt;  but 
faculties  would  often  not  be  taken  on  those 
terms,  and  they  are  probably  only  insisted 
on  when  there  appears  some  special  reason 


FACULTY 

for  it.  Sometimes  it  is  exjjedient  to  limit 
the  time  for  a  faculty  to  last,  especially  as 
they  are  irrevocable.  But  all  these  things 
depend  on  the  circumstances,  and  what 
would  accelerate  the  work  in  one  case 
might  prevent  it  altogether  in  another. 

Though  it  is  not  usual  to  insist  on 
faculties  being  taken  for  small  alterations 
which  cannot  rationally  be  objected  to,  or 
such  things  as  adding  a  few  more  beUs  or 
a  clock  (provided  the  dial  does  not  spoil 
the  tower,  as  at  St.  Mary's,  Beverley)  it 
should  be  understood  that  making  impor- 
tant alterations  without  a  faculty  is  a 
serious  ecclesiastical  offence  {Sieveking  v. 
Eingsford,  36  L.  J.  Ecc.  1866) ;  and  the 
person  who  does  so,  whether  layman  or  clergy- 
man, may  be  ordered  to  restore  the  church 
to  its  former  condition,  and  signified  for  con- 
tempt and  imprisoned  if  he  disobeys  the 
monition.  And  even  if  a  confirmatory 
faculty  is  ultimately  granted  on  some 
conditions  short  of  entire  removal,  he  is 
certain  to  be  condemned  in  the  costs  of  the 
suit.  A  man  has  been  monished,  i.e.  pro- 
hibited, from  building  so  near  a  church  as 
to  darken  it;  and  on  the  other  hand 
a  neighbour  to  a  chm'chyard  was  held 
to  have  an  interest  to  oppose  the  build- 
ing of  a  mortuary  or  dead-house  close 
to  him.  Faculties  have  beea  granted  for 
turning  disused  churchyards  into  gardens; 
but  refused  as  ultra  vires  for  throwing  a  part 
of  the  churchyard  into  a  street.  The  Dean 
of  Arches  has  refused  to  allow  steps  round  a 
communion  table  as  tending  to  make  it 
imitate  an  altar,  and  also  chancel  gates, 
and  high  screens,  and  a  crucifix  any^vhere, 
but  not  groups  of  statuary ;  both  which 
decisions  the  Privy  Council  affirmed;  and 
see  Ornaments  as  to  other  things  of  the 
same  kind.  Faculties  are  also  requisite  to 
protect  incumbents  who  want  to  remove 
useless  buildings  on  their  glebe  from  being 
charged  for  them  as  dilapidations  if  they  do 
it  without  one.  By  an  Act  of  1882,  it  is 
unlawful  to  build  anything  except  an  en- 
largement of  the  church  in  a  burial-ground 
that  has  been  closed  by  order  of  Council 
(See&AooZ).    [G.] 

FACULTY  COURT  belongs  to  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury,  and  his  ofiicer  is 
called  the  Master  of  the  Faculties.  His 
power  is  to  grant  dispensation  to  marry,  to 
hold  two  or  more  benefices  ordinarily  in- 
compatible, and  such  like.  But  the  law  of 
]iluralities  is  all  now  regulated  by  Acts  of 
Parliament,  especially  1  &  2  Vict.  c.  106 ; 
but  still  dispensations  are  requisite  (See 
fluralities'). 

FAITH  (See  Grace,  Justification). 
"  We  are  accounted  righteous  before  God, 
only  for  the  merit  of  our  Lord  and  Saviour 
Jesus  Christ,  by  Faith,  and  not  for  our  own 


FAITH 


S45 


works  or  deservings.  Wherefore,  that  we 
are  justified  by  faith  only  is  a  most  whole- 
some doctrine,  and  very  full  of  comfort,  as 
more  largely  is  expressed  in  the  Homily  of 
Justification." — Article  XI. 

Faith,  in  its  generic  sense,  either  means 
the  holding  rightly  the  creeds  of  the  Catho- 
lic Church,  or  means  that  very  Catholic 
faith,  which  except  a  man  believe  faithfully, 
he  cannot  be  saved.  Thus,  when  the  priest 
is  directed,  in  the  office  for  the  Baptism  of 
those  of  Eiper  Years,  to  inquire  into  the 
faith  of  the  candidate,  he  asks  his  assent  to 
one  of  the  creeds ;  and,  in  the  ofiice  for  the 
Visitation  of  the  Sick,  he  is  required  to 
use  the  same  test,  and  this  of  course  agrees 
with  St.  Paul's  statement :  "  With  the  heart 
man  beheveth  unto  righteousness,  and  with 
the  mouth  confession  is  made  unto  salva- 
tion." 

It  should  be  noted,  that  we  are  justified 
hy  faith,  not  because  of  faith ;  for  there  is 
no  more  "merit"  in  our  faith,  than  in  our 
works.  Faith  therefore  is  not  the  cause, 
but  the  condition,  of  our  justification, 
which  is  solely  to  be  attributed  to  the 
bounty  of  God,  and  the  merits  of  Christ. 
— Archdeacon  Welchinan. 

There  is  not  any  one  word  which  has 
more  significations  than  this  has  in  the 
word  of  Gisd,  especially  in  the  New  Testa- 
ment. It  sometimes  signifies  the  acknow- 
ledgment of  the  true  God,  in  opposition  to 
heathenism;  sometimes  the  Christian  reli- 
gion, in  opposition  to  Judaisiii ;  sometimes 
the  beheving  the  power  of  Christ  to  heal 
diseases  ;  sometimes  the  believing  that  he  is 
the  promised  Messias ;  sometimes  fidelity  or 
faithfulness ;  sometimes  a  resolution  of  con- 
science concerning  the  lawfulness  of  any- 
thing :  sometimes  a  reliance,  afiSance,  or 
dependence  on  Christ  either  for  temporal  or 
spiritual  matters;  sometimes  believing  the 
truth  of  all  Divine  relations ;  sometimes 
obedience  to  God's  commands  in  the  evan- 
gelical, not  legal  sense;  sometimes  the 
doctrine  of  the  gospel,  in  opposition  to  the 
law  of  Moses ;  sometimes  it  is  an  aggregate  of 
all  other  graces ;  sometimes  the  condition  of 
the  second  covenant  in  opposition  to  the 
first :  and  other  senses  of  it  also  there  are, 
distingrdshable  by  the  contexture,  and  the 
matter  treated  of  where  the  word  is  used. — 
Hammond,  Practical  Catechism. 

With  regard  to  the  phrase,  "  Instrumen- 
tality of  Faith,"  Waterland  says  that 
some  very  eminent  men  have  expressed  a 
dislike  of  it ;  and  have  also  justly  rejected  the 
thing,  according  to  the  false  notion  which 
some  had  conceived  of  it.  It  cannot,  with 
any  tolerable  sense  or  propriety,  be  looked 
upon  as  an  instrument  of  conveyance  in  the 
hand  of  the  efficient  or  principal  cause ;  but 
it  may  justl3'  and  properly  be  looked  upon 


346 


FAITH 


as  the  instrument  of  reception  in  the  hand 
of  the  recipient.  It  is  not  the  mean  by 
which,  the  grace  is  wrought,  effocted,  or  con- 
ferred ;  hut  it  may  he,  and  is,  the  mean  by 
which  it  is  accepted  or  received:  or,  to 
express  it  a  little  differently,  it  is  not  the 
instrument  of  justification  in  the  active  sense 
of  the  word,  but  it  is  in  the  passive  sense  of 
it.  It  cannot  be  for  nothing  that  St.  Paul 
so  often  and  so  emphatically  speaks  of  man's 
being  justified  by  faith,  or  through  faith  in 
Christ's  blood ;  and  that  he  particularly 
notes  it  of  Abraham,  that  he  believed,  and 
that  his  faith  was  counted  to  him  for  justifi- 
cation ;  when  he  might  as  easily  have  said, 
had  he  so  meant,  that  man  is  justified  by 
faith  and  works,  or  that  Abraham,  to  whom 
the  gospel  was  preached,  was  justified  by 
gospel  faith  and  obedience.  Besides,  it  is 
certain,  and  is  on  all  hands  allowed,  that, 
though  St.  Paul  did  not  directly  and  ex- 
pressly oppose  faith  to  evangelical  works, 
yet  he  comprehended  the  works  of  the  moral 
law  under  those  works  which  he  excluded 
from  the  office  of  justifying,  in  his  sense  of 
justifying,  in  those  passages  ;  and  further,  he 
used  such  arguments  as  appear  to  extend  to 
all  kinds  of  works :  for  Abraham's  works 
were  really  evangelical  works,  and  yet  they 
were  excluded.  Add  to  this,  that  if  justifica- 
tion could  come  even  by  evangeUcal  works, 
without  taking  in  faith  in  the  meritorious 
sufferings  and  satisfaction  of  a  mediator,  then 
might  we  have  "  whereof  to  glory  "  as  need- 
ing no  pardon ;  and  then  might  it  be  justly 
said,  that  "Christ  died  in  vain."  I  must 
further  own,  that  it  is  of  great  weight  with 
me,  that  so  early  and  so  considerable  a  writer 
as  Clemens  of  Rome,  an  apostolical  man, 
should  so  interpret  the  doctrine  of  justifying 
faith,  so  as  to  oppose  it  plainly  even  to 
evangelical  works,  however  exalted.  It  runs 
thus  :  "  They  (the  ancient  patriarchs)  were 
all,  therefore,  greatly  glorified  and  magnified ; 
not  for  their  own  sake,  or  for  their  own 
works,  or  for  the  righteousness  which  they 
themselves  wrought,  hut  through  his  good 
pleasure.  And  we  also,  being  called  through 
his  good  pleasure  in  Christ  Jesus,  are  not 
justified  by  ourselves,  neither  by  our  own 
wisdom,  or  knowledge,  or  piety,  or  the  works 
which  we  have  done  in  hohness  of  heart, 
but  by  that  faith  by  which  Almighty  God 
justified  all  from  the  beginning."  Here  it 
is  observable,  that  the  w  or  A  faitli  does  not 
stand  for  the  whole  system  of  Christianity, 
or  for  Christian  belief  at  large,  but  for  some 
particular  self-denying  principle  by  which 
good  men,  even  under  the  patriarchal  and 
legal  dispensations,  laid  hold  on  the  mercy 
and  promises  of  God,  referring  all,  not  to 
themselves  or  their  own  deservings,  hut  to 
Divine  goodness,  in  and  through  a  mediator. 
It  is  true,  Clemens  elsewhere,  and  St.  Paul 


FAITH 

almost  everywhere,  insists  upon  true  holi- 
ness of  heart,  and  obedience  of  life,  as  indis- 
pensable conditions  of  salvation  or  justifica- 
tion ;  and  of  that  one  would  think  there 
could  be  no  question  among  men  of  any 
judgment  or  probity :  but  the  question 
about  conditions  is  very  distinct  from  the 
other  question  about  instruments ;  and, 
therefore,  both  parts  may  be  true,  viz.  that 
faith  and  obedience  are  equally  conditions, 
and  equally  indispensable  where  oppor- 
tunities permit ;  and  yet  faith  over  and  above 
is  emphatically  the  instrument  both  of  re- 
ceiving and  holding  justification,  or  a  title 
to  salvation. 

To  explain  this  matter  more  distinctly, 
let  it  he  remembered,  that  God  may  he  con- 
sidered (as  has  been  before  noted)  either  as  a 
party  contracting  with  man,  on  very  gra- 
cious terms,  or  as  a  judge  to  pronounce 
judgment  upon  him. 

Man's  first  coming  into  covenant  (sup- 
posing him  adult)  is  by  assenting  to  it,  and 
accepting  of  it,  to  have  and  to  hold  it  on 
such  kind  of  tenure  as  God  proposes :  that 
is  to  say,  upon  a  self-denying  tenure,  con- 
sidering himself  as  a  guilty  man,  standing 
in  need  of  pardon,  and  of  borrowed  merits, 
and  at  length  resting  upon  mercy.  So 
here  the  previous  question  is,  whether  a 
person  shall  consent  to  hold  a  privilege 
upon  this  submissive  kind  of  tenure  or 
not  ?  Such  assent  or  consent,  if  he  comes 
into  it,  is  the  very  thing  which  St.  Paul 
and  St.  Clemens  call  faith ;  and  this  pre- 
vious and  general  question  is  the  question 
which  both  of  them  determine  against  any 
proud  claimants  who  would  hold  by  a 
more  self-admiring  tenure. 

Or,  if  we  next  consider  God  as  sitting  in 
judgment,  and  man  before  the  tribunal, 
going  to  plead  his  cause ;  here  the  ques- 
tion is.  What  kind  of  plea  shall  a  man  re- 
solve to  trust  his  salvation  upon?  Shall 
he  stand  upon  his  innocence,  and  rest  upon 
strict  law ;  or  shall  he  plead  guilty,  and 
rest  in  an  act  of  grace  ?  If  he  chooses  the 
former,  he  is  proud,  and  sure  to  be  cast; 
if  he  chooses  the  latter,  he  is  safe  so  far, 
in  throwing  himself  upon  an  act  of  grace. 
Now  this  question  also,  which  St.  Paul  has 
decided,  is  previous  to  the  question,  what 
conditions  even  the  act  of  grace  itself 
finally  insists  upon?  A  question  which 
St.  James  in  particular,  and  the  general 
tenor  of  the  whole  Scripture,  has  abund- 
antly satisfied ;  and  which  could  never  have 
been  made  a  question  by  any  considerate  or 
impartial  Christian.  "What  I  am  at  present 
concerned  with  is  to  observe,  that  faith  is 
emphatically  the  instrument  by  which  an 
adult  accepts  the  covenant  of  grace,  consent- 
ing to  hold  by  that  kind  of  tenure,  to  be 
justified  in  that  way,  and  to  rest  in  that 


FAITH 

kind  of  plea,  putting  his  salvation  on  that 
only  issue.*  It  appears  to  be  a  just  observa- 
tion which  Dr.  Whitby  makes  (Pref.  to  the 
Epist.  to  Oalat.  p.  300),  that  Abraham  had 
faith  (Heb.  xi.  8)  before  what  was  said  of 
his  justification  in  Gen.  xv.  6,  and  after- 
wards more  abimdantly,  when  he  offered  up 
his  son  Isaac;  but  yet  neither  of  those 
instances  was  pitched  upon  by  the  apostle 
as  fit  for  his  purpose,  because  La  both, 
obedience  was  joined  with  faith  :  whereas, 
here  was  a  pure  act  of  faith,  without  works, 
and  of  this  act  of  faith  it  is  said,  "  it  was 
imputed  to  him  for  righteousness.''  The 
sum  is,  none  of  our  works  are  good  enough 
to  stand  by  themselves  before  Him  who  is 
of  purer  eyes  than  to  behold  iniquity. 
Christ  only  is  pure  enough  for  it  at  first 
hand,  and  they  that  are  Christ's  at  second 
hand,  in  and  through  Him.  Now,  because 
it  is  by  faith  that  we  thus  interpose,  as  it 
were,  Christ  between  God  and  us,  in  order 
to  gain  acceptance  by  Him ;  therefore  faith 
is  emphatically  the  instrument  whereby  we 
receive  the  grant  of  justification.  Obedience 
is  equally  a  condition  or  qualification,  but 
not  an  instrument,  not  being  that  act  of  the 
mind  whereby  we  look  up  to  God  and 
Christ,  and  whereby  we  embrace  the  pro- 
mises.— Waterland  on  Justification. 

FAITH,  IMPLICIT  (See  Implicit 
Faith). 

FAITHFUL  (jTioTot:  fideles).  This 
was  the  name  uniformly  used  in  the  primi- 
tive Church,  to  distinguish  those  who  had 
been  instructed  in  the  Christian  religion, 
"tthd  received  by  baptism  into  the  full 
communion  of  the  Church  from  the  cate- 
chumens and  penitents. 

TheJHoly  Eucharist- was  called  'Kcirovpyla 
tS>v  wicrrav ;  misaa  fidelium ;  in  distinction 
to  the  Xctroupyia  raiv  KanjxoTJf^^vav,  missa 
catechumenorum,  which  consisted  of  reading 
of  the  Scriptures,  prayers  and  hymns.  The 
faithful  were  allowed  to  join  in  all  the 
prayers  of  the  Church,  and  the  Lord's 
Prayer  is  called  by  St.  Chrysostom  "  evxfj 
TTia-Tav,"  and  by  St.  Augustine  "oratio 
fidelium."  The  apostolical  epistles  are  all 
addressed  to  the  "  faithful,"  that  is,  to  those 
who  being  admitted  to  the  full  communion 
of  the  Church  were  privileged  to  hear  dis- 
courses upon  the  most  profound  mysteries 
of  rehgion. — St.  Chrys.  Horn.  ii.  in  2  Cor. : 
Bom.  X.  in  Colos. ;  St.  August.  Eom.  xxix. 
de  verb.  Apost. ;  Serm.  i.  ad  Neophytos ;  St. 
Ambrose,  de  his  qui  mysteriis  initiantur, 

0.1. 

Other  names  were  at  different  times,  and 
in  different  places,  given  to   the  faithful, 

*  [The  verses  in  St.  James  L  of  which  Luther  spoke  so 
disrespectfully  assert  the  necessity  of  faith  as  much  as 
any  in  St.  Paul's  epistles.  Works  were  not  to  be  a  sub- 
stitute for  faith,  but  a  proof  of  it,  when  there  is  time  to 
do  them.]   [G.] 


FAMILIAES 


347 


as  Qeof^opoi,  Ecclesiastici,  &o.,  all  these 
names  expressing  soTne  relation  to  God  or 
to  Christ,  and  none  of  them  taken  from  the 
names  of  men,  as  was  and  is  the  case  with  the 
heresies  and  sects." — Bingham,  i.  c.  iv. ;  Diet. 
Christ.  Ant.,  s.v. ;  see  Methodists,  Indepen- 
dents, &c.     [H.] 

PALDISTOKY.  (FaldesfoUum;  Faldis- 
torium.)  A  low  crossed  or  folding  stool 
which  might  be  used  either  to  kneel  at  or  to- 
sit  upon.  It  is  derived  "a  longo  tardico 
falden,  plicare ;  et  stoul,  sedes  "  (Ducange). 
In  ecclesiastical  use  it  became  limited  to  the 
episcopal  seat  within  the  chancel ;  but  more 
particularly,  the  bishop's  chair,  which  was 
generally  a  folding  one,  near  the  altar, 
mentioned  in  the  Ordination  Service,  in 
which  he  sits,  while  addressing  the  candi- 
dates for  orders,  &c. 

FALDSTOOL  is  the  English  form  of  the 
Faldestolium.  In  the  "  Order  of  Her 
Majesty's  Coronation  "  the  rubric  speaks  of 
a  Fald-stool  at  which  the  sovereign  shall 
kneel.  But  this,  according  to  pictures  of  late 
coronations,  has  lost  its  original  shape,  and 
is  merely  a  kneeling  stool  (Maskell,  Mon. 
Bit.  ii.  92).  And  this  is  generally  the  case, 
for  the  word  has  come  to  mean  a  small 
desk,  at  which  the  Litany  is  enjoined  to  be 
sung  or  said.  In  the  rubric  before  the  51st 
psaGn  in  the  Commination  Service,  a 
peculiar  place  distinct  from  that  in  which 
the  ordinary  offices  are  performed,  is  im- 
plied. The  Injunctions  of  Edward,  followed 
in  this  case  by  those  of  Elizabeth,  specified 
the  midst  of  the  church.  Bishop  Andrewes 
had  in  his  chapel  a  faldstool  (faldistory) 
between  the  western  stalls  and  the  lectern. 
Bishop  Cosin  in  his  first  series  of  notes  on 
the  Common  Prayer  says,  "  the  priest  goeth 
from  out  his  seat  into  the  body  of  the 
church,  and  at  a  low  desk  before  the 
chancel  door,  called  the  faldstool,  kneels 
and  says  or  sings  the  Litany." — Blunt's 
Annot.  P.  B.  i.  48.     [H.] 

PALL  OP  MAN.  (  See  Original  Sin.) 
The  loss  of  those  perfections  and  that  hap- 
piness which  his  Maker  bestowed  on  man 
at  his  creation,  for  the  transgression  of  a 
positive  conmaand,  given  for  the  trial  of 
his  obedience.  This  doctrine  is  stated 
in  the  language  of  our  ninth  Article, — "  On 
original  sin." 

FAMILIARS  OP  THE  INQUISI- 
TION (See  Inquisition).  In  order  to 
support  the  cruel  proceedings  of  the  In- 
quisition in  Spain,  great  privileges  were 
bestowed  upon  such  of  the  nobility  as  were 
willing  to  degrade  themselves  so  far  as  to 
become  familiars  of  the  holy  office.  The 
king  himself,  Philip  II.,  assumed  the  title, 
and  was  protector  of  the  order. 

The  business  of  these  familiars  was  to 
assist  in  tho  apprehending  of  such  persons 


318 


FANATICISM 


as  were  accused,  and  to  carry  tliem  to 
prison ;  upon  which,  occasion  the  unhappy 
person  was  surrounded  by  such  a  number 
of  these  ofiSoials  that,  though  he  was  neither 
fettered  nor  bound,  there  was  no  possibility 
of  escaping  out  of  their  hands.  As  a  reward 
of  this  base  emplojinent,  the  familiars  were 
allowed  to  commit  the  most  enormous 
actions,  to  debauch,  assassinate,  and  kiE  with 
impunity.  If  they  happened  to  be  prose- 
cuted for  any  crime,  the  Inquisition  took 
upon  itself  the  prosecution,  and  immedi- 
ately the  familiar  entered  himself  as  then- 
prisoner  ;  after  which  he  was  at  Uberty  to 
go  where  he  pleased,  and  act  in  all  things 
as  if  he  were  free. 

FANATICISM.  Such  an  excessive  en- 
thusiasm and  zeal  for  the  cause  which  they 
beUeve  to  be  the  cause  of  truth  as  induces 
men  to  pursue  their  ends  by  violent  or  frau- 
dulent meiins,  and  to  violate  the  Christian 
law  of  charity  and  forbearance. 

FARSE.  An  addition,  used  before  the 
Eeformation,  in  the  vernacular  tongue,  to 
the  Epistle  in  Latin,  anciently  used  in  some 
churches,  forming  an  explication  or  para- 
phrase of  the  Latin  text,  verse  by  verse, 
for  the  benefit  of  the  people.  The  sub- 
deacon  first  repeated  each  verse  of  the 
epistle  or  lectio  in  Latin,  and  two  choris- 
ters sang  the  farse  or  explanation  (See 
Burney's  Hist.  Music,  ii.  256). 

PASTINa  (See  Abstinence  and  Fasts). 
Total  or  partial  abstinence  from  food. 

By  the  regulations  of  the  Church,  fasting, 
though  not  defined  as  to  its  degree,  is  in- 
culcated at  seasons  of  peculiar  penitence 
and  humiliation,  as  a  valuable  auxiliary  to 
the  cultivation  of  habits  of  devotion  and 
self-denial.  Respecting  its  usefulness,  there 
does  not  appear  to  have  been  much  diver- 
sity of  opinion  until  late  years.  Fasting 
was  customary  in  the  Church  of  God  long 
before  the  introduction  of  Christianity,  as 
may  be  seen  in  the  Old  Testament  Scrip- 
tures. It  was  sanctioned  by  our  blessed 
Lord,  who  gave  his  disciples  particular 
instruction  respecting  it,  and  it  was  after- 
wards practised  by  the  apostles,  especially 
before  entering  upon  any  solemn  act  or  duty 
(St.  Matt.  vi.  16 ,-  Acts  xiii.  3,  &c.). 

From  the  days  of  the  apostles  to  the 
present  time,  fasting  has  been  regarded 
under  various  modifications  as  a  valuable 
auxiliary  to  penitence.  In  former  times. 
Christians  were  exceedingly  strict  in  their 
fasting  for  nearly  the  whole  of  the  appointed 
days,  receiving  only  at  stated  times  what 
was  actually  necessary  for  the  support  of 
life.  "  There  are  those,"  says  St.  Chrysostom, 
"  who  rival  one  another  in  fasting,  and  show 
a  marvellous  emulation  in  it ;  some,  indeed, 
who  spend  the  whole  day  without  food ;  and 
others  who,  rejecting  from  their  tables  not 


FASTING 

only  the  use  of  wine  and  of  oil,  and  of  every 
dish,  and  taking  only  bread  and  water, 
persevere  in  this  practice  during  the  whole 
of  Lent."  And  the  historian  Socrates  gives  a 
similar  account :  "  some  abstain  from  every 
creature  that  has  life :  others  eat  fish  only : 
others  birds,  because  they  too  at  the  creation 
sprang  from  water  :  others  abstain  from 
eggs,"  &C.—H.  E.  V.  22. 

At  the  season  of  Lent,  it  was  always  the 
custom  to  observe  the  duties  of  mortification 
and  open  confession  of  sin,  accompanied  by 
those  outward  acts  which  tend  to  the  control 
of  the  body  and  its  appetites ;  a  species  of 
godly  discipline  still  associated  with  the  ser- 
vices of  that  solemn  period  of  the  ecclesias- 
tical year.  There  were  eight  rules  enjoined 
by  the  Fathers  of  the  Church  at  different 
times  with  regard  to  fasting,  (1)  that  it 
should  be  joined  with  repentance,  (2)  a  real 
abstinence  from  all  forms  of  indulgence  (3) 
joined  with  watchings,  with  (4)  undoing 
heavy  burdens,  with  (5)  alms-deeds  (6)  sub- 
servient to  prayer,  with  frequent  hearing  of 
God's  word  (7)  used  as  a  preparation  for 
receiving  (baptism),  absolution,  or  the 
eucharist  (8)  free  from  hypocrisy  (St. 
Chrysostom,  Horn,  els  tovs  to.  jrpara  ndaxa 
vrjorevovTas,  vol.  i.  p.  611 ;  see  Gunning's 
Lent  Fast,  pp.  132-159).  Our  Church  lays 
down  no  definite  rules  on  the  mode  of 
fasting,  but  leaves  it  for  each  individual  to 
settle  for  himself.  In  the  Homily  "Of  Good 
works,  and  of  Fasting,"  three  objects  are 
mentioned— to  chastise  the  flesh ;  to  make 
the  spirit  fervent  in  prayer;  to  be  a  testi- 
mony of  our  submission  to  God.  In  the 
practice  of  fasting,  the  Christian  will  not 
rest  in  the  outward  act,  but  regard  it  only 
as  a  means  to  a  good  end.  This  being 
understood,  fasting  vrill  be  approved  of  God, 
and  made  conducive  to  a  growth  in  spiritual 
life. 

The  distinction  between  the  Protestant 
and  the  Roman  view  of  fasting  is  this,  that, 
the  Roman  regards  the  use  of  fasting  as  a 
means  of  grace ;  the  Protestant,  only  as  a 
useful  exercise.  It  is  not  a,  means  of  grace, 
for  it  is  nowhere  ordained  as  such  in  the 
Scriptures  of  the  New  Testament ;  but  it  is 
a  useful  preparation  for  the  means  of  grace, 
and  as  such  the  Scriptures  have  assumed 
that  it  will  be  resorted  to  by  Christians. 

FASTING  BEFORE  COMMUNION. 
I.  There  is  no  doubt  that  in  the  primitive 
times  the  Holy  Communion  was  not  received 
fasting.  It  often  accompanied  or  followed 
an  agape,  or  a  common  meaL  But  this 
was  soon  found  to  be  inexpedient,  and  in 
the  tune  of  Tertullian  and  St.  Cyprian 
there  seems  to  have  been  different  order, 
the  latter  speaking  of  the  advantage  of 
morning  over  evening  communion  (Ep.  Lxiii. 
C.15,  &o. ;  TertuU.  de  Orat.  c.  14).     Still 


FASTING 

the  rule  of  communicating  fasting  does  not 
appear  to  liave  been  recognised  before  tiie 
fourth  century.  St.  Basil  spealfs  of  no  one 
celebrating  the  mysteries  otherwise  than 
fasting  (Horn.  ii. — De  Jefuniis).  St. 
Augustine  says,  "  It  is  plain  that  when  the 
disciples  first  received  the  Body  and  Blood 
of  the  Lord,  they  received  it  not  fasting. 
Does  any  one  then  on  this  account  blame  the 
Universal  Church  because  it  always  received 
fosting?  Nay,  for  it  hath  pleased  the 
Holy  Grhost  that,  in  honour  of  so  great  a 
Sacrament,  the  Body  of  the  Lord  should 
enter  the  mouth  of  the  Christian  before  any 
other  food,  for  it  is  the  custom  observed 
throughout  the  world.  .  .  He  Himself  ab- 
stained from  ordering  in  what  manner  it 
should  be  received,  so  it  was  left  for  His 
Apostles,  by  whom  He  was  about  to  arrange 
His  Church"  {Ep.  cxviii.  ad  Januar.). 
St.  Chrysostom,  when  charged  with  adminis- 
tering the  Holy  Communion  to  those  who 
were  not  fasting,  indignantly  denied  the 
charge ;  and  he  elsewhere  refers  to  the  sub- 
ject (^Ep.  cxxv.  p.  683 ;  in  1  Cor.,  Horn. 
xxvii.  See  Stephens'  Life,  p.  314,  2nd 
Ed.).  An  exception  was  made  on  the  day 
when  the  institution  of  the  Lord's  Supper 
was  commemorated.  Socrates  spealis  of 
certain  congregations  in  Egypt,  near  Alex- 
andria, who  communicated  occasionally  after 
their  evening  meal  {H.  E.  v.  22).  But 
this  was  an  exceptional  case.  The  rule  was 
that  celebrant  and  communicants  alike 
should  receive  fasting,  and  this  was  con- 
firmed by  many  councils,  such  as  that  of 
Carthage,  a.d.  397  (iii.  c.  29). 

II.  But  there  is  no  rule  given  as  to  how 
long  before,  there  must  have  been  fasting, 
and  it  woiild  seem  only  to  be  implied  that 
the  Holy  Communion  was  not  to  be 
celebrated  after  the  principal  meal  was 
taken.  Thus  it  was  ordered  by  the  Coun- 
cil of  Macon  (ii.  c.  6),  that  no  presbyter 
with  a  full  stomach  or  having  indulged 
in  wine  shall  presume  to  celebrate :  this 
implying  that  it  was  forbidden  to  celebrate 
directly  after  the  meal ;  nor  does  it  appear 
that  either  the  early  Fathers  of  the  Church, 
or  the  early  Canons  prohibited  such  small 
quantities  of  food  as  might  be  necessary 
to  enable  persons  to  go  through  their 
duties  without  exhaustion,  which  however 
should  be  taken  as  long  time  as  possible 
before  celebrating  or  communicating,  as  a 
matter  of  reverence. 

The  Council  of  Constance  (a.d.  1414) 
declared  that  ''  after  much  and  mature 
deliberation  had  of  many  who  are  learned 
both  in  Divine  and  human  law,  although 
Christ  instituted  this  venerable  sacrament 
after  supper,  and  administered  it  to  His 
disciples  under  both  kinds  of  bread  and 
wine,  yet,  notwithstanding  this,  the  laudable 


FATHERS 


34& 


authority  of  the  sacred  canons,  and  the 
approved  custom  of  the  Church  has  ob- 
served, that  this  sacrament  ought  not  to  bo 
performed  after  supper,  nor  be  received  by 
the  faithful  unless  fasting,  except  in  the  case 
of  sickness,  or  any  other  necessity,  either 
duly  conceded  or  admitted  by  the  Church." 

The  Council  held  at  Mayence  in  1549 
forbad  the  ministers  of  Churches  to  give- 
the  Eucharist  to  any  except  those  who  are 
fasting  and  have  made  confession.  The 
Church  of  England,  like  the  primitive 
Church,  has  no  such  laws ;  and  as  con- 
fession is  left  to  the  discretion  of  individuals 
(see  first  exhortation  in  the  Communioa 
Service),  so  it  is  in  the  case  of  fasting  Com- 
munion.    [H.] 

FASTS.  Those  days  which  are  appointed 
by  the  Church  as  seasons  of  abstinence  and. 
peculiar  sorrow  for  sin.  These  are  the  forty 
days  of  Lent,  including  Ash  Wednesday  and 
Good  Friday;  the  Ember  days,  the  three 
Rogation  days,  and  all  the  Fridays  in  the 
year  (except  Christmas  Day),  and  the  eves 
or  vigils  of  certain  festivals. 

The  Ember  days  are  the  Wednesday, 
Friday,  and  Saturday  before  the  first  Sunday 
in  Lent ;  Trinity  Sunday :  Sept.  14 ;  Dec.  IS 
(See  Ember  Days).  The  Eogation  days  are 
the  three  days  preceding  Ascension  Day  (See 
Itogation  Days).  The  eves  or  vigils  to  be 
observed  are  those  before  the  Nativity  of  our 
Lord,  the  Purification  of  the  Blessed  Virgin 
Mary,  the  Annunciation  of  the  Blessed 
Virgin,  Easter  Day,  Ascension  Day, 
Pentecost,  St.  Matthias,  St.  John  Baptist,^ 
St.  Peter,  St.  James,  St.  Bartholomew,  St. 
Matthew,  St.  Simon  and  St.  Jude,  St. 
Andrew,  St.  Thomas,  All  Saints.  And  if 
any  of  these  feasts  fall  upon  a  Monday,  then 
the  vigil  or  fast  day  shall  be  kept  upon  the 
Saturday,  and  not  upon  the  Sunday,  next 
before  it  (See  Vigils'). 

By  Canon  72.  "  No  minister  shall,  with- 
out the  licence  and  direction  of  the  bishop 
under  hand  and  seal,  appoint  or  keep  any 
solemn  fasts,  either  publicly,  or  in  any 
private  houses,  other  than  such  as  by  law 
are,  or  by  public  authority  shall  be,  ap- 
pointed, nor  shall  be  wittingly  present  at 
any  of  them ;  under  pain  of  suspension  for 
the  first  fault,  of  excommunication  for  the 
second,  and  of  deposition  from  the  ministry 
for  the  third  "  (See  Fasting). 

FATHERS,  THE.  A  term  of  honour 
applied  generally  to  all  the  ancient  Chris- 
tian writers,  whose  works  were  in  good 
repute  in  the  Church,  and  who  were  not 
separated  from  its  communion  or  from  its- 
faith.  St.  Bernard,  who  flourished  in  the 
twelfth  century,  is  reputed  to  be  the  last 
of  the  Fathers.  The  Christian  theologians- 
after  his  time,  adopted  a  new  style  of 
treating  religious  matters,  and  were  called 


350 


FATHERS 


scholastics.  Those  writers  who  conversed 
with  the  apostles  are  generally  called  apo- 
stolical Fathers,  as  Ignatius,  &c.  (See  Apo- 
&tolic  Fathers). 

Of  the  other  Fathers  the  chief  were 
Justin  Martyr  (a.d.  103-164) ;  St.  Irenceus, 
bishop  of  Lyons  (140-202),  a  disciple  of 
St.  Polycarp,  called  by  Tertullian  "  Omnium 
doctrinaram  curiosissimus  explorator ;  " 
St.  Clement  of  Alexandria  (d.  circ.  216) ; 
Tertullian  (circ.  194-216);  Origen  (185- 
265) ;  St.  Cyprian,  bishop  of  Carthage 
(200-258);  St.  Gregory  Thaumatursus, 
bishop  of  Neo-Ceesarea  (d.  265) ;  St.  Dio- 
nysius,  bishop  of  Alexandria  (247) ;  Lactan- 
tius  (320) ;  Eusebius,  bishop  of  Csesarea 
(d.  338);  St.  Athanasius,  bishop  of  Alex- 
andria (d.  373);  St.  Cyril,  bishop  of 
Jerusalem  (d.  386);  St.  Hilary,  bishop 
of  Poictiers  (d.  367)  ;  St.  Basil,  bishop 
of  C«sarea  (326-380) ;  St.  Gregory  Nyssen, 
brother  of  St.  Basil,  bishop  of  Nyssa  (332- 
396) ;  St.  Gregory  Nazianzen — so  called  from 
Nazianzus,  which  was  near  his  birthplace — 
patriarch  of  Constantinople  (329-389) ;  St. 
Ambrose,  bishop  of  Milan  (340-396) ;  St. 
John  Chrysostom  (347-407);  St.  Jerome 
(345-420) ;  Euffinus  ;  St.  Augustine,  bishop 
of  Hippo  (354-430) ;  St.  Cyril,  bishop  of 
Alexandria  (d.  444)  Socrates  (380-440); 
Sozomen,  about  same  date;  Theodoret, 
bishop  of  Cyrus  (386^30) ;  St.  Leo,  bishop 
of  Eome  (d.  461). 

Of  the  authority  of  the  Fathers,  the  Eev. 
Geo.  Stanley  Faber  observes :  "  Among 
certain  persons  of  the  present  somewhat 
confident  age,  it  is  not  an  uncommon  saying, 
that  THBT  disregard  the  early  Fathers ;  and 
that  THEY  will  (Aide  hy  nothing  hut  the  Scrip- 
tures alone.  If  by  a  disregard  of  the  early 
Fathers,  they  mean  that  they  allow  them 
cot  individually  that  personal  authority 
which  the  Eomanists  claim  for  them,  they 
certainly  will  not  have  me  for  their  oppo- 
nent. And  accordingly  I  have  shown, 
that  in  the  interpretation  of  the  Scriptmre 
terms.  Election  and  Predestination,  I  regard 
the  insulated  individual  authority  of  St. 
Augustine  just  as  little  as  I  regard  the 
insulated  individual  authority  of  Calvin. 

"  But  if  by  a  disregard  of  the  early 
Fathers,  they  mean  that  they  regard  them 
not  as  evidence  of  the  fact  of  what  doc- 
trines were  or  were  not  received  by  the 
primitive  Church,  and  from  her  were  or 
were  not  delivered  to  posterity,  they  might 
just  as  rationally  talk  of  the  surpassing 
msdom  of  extinguishing  the  light  of  his- 
tory, by  way  of  more  effectually  improving 
and  increasing  our  knowledge  of  past  events ; 
for,  in  truth,  under  the  aspect  in  which 
they  are  specially  important  to  its,  the 
early  Fathers  are  neither  more  nor  less 
than  so  many  historical  witnesses. 


FEASTS 

"  And  if,  by  an  abiding  soldy  hy  the 
decision  of  Scripture,  they  mean  that,  ut- 
terly disregarding  the  recorded  doctrinal 
system  of  that  primitive  Church  which 
conversed  with,  and  was  taught  by,  the 
apostles,  they  will  abide  by  nothing  save 
their  own  arbitrary  private  expositions 
of  Scripture;  we  certainly  miay  well 
admire  their  intrepidity,  whatever  we  may 
think  of  their  modesty ;  for  in  truth,  by 
such  a  plan,  while  they  call  upon  us  to 
despise  the  sentiments  of  Christian  anti- 
quity, so  far  as  we  can  learn  them,  upon 
distinct  historical  testimony,  they  expect 
us  to  receive,  without  hesitation,  and  as 
undoubted  verities,  their  own  more  modem 
speculations  upon  the  sense  of  God's  holy 
word;  that  is  to  say,  the  evidence  of 
the  early  Fathers,  and  the  hermeneutio 
decisions  of  the  primitive  Church,  we  may 
laudably  and  profitably  contemn,  but  them^ 
selves  we  must  receive  (for  they  themselves 
are  content  to  receive  themselves)  as  well- 
nigh  certain  and  infallible  expositors  of 
Scripture." 

(There  is  a  chronological  account  or  short 
lives  of  all  the  Fathers  in  a  book  called  Church 
JfcmonaZs, by thelateW.Eoberts,M.A.)  [H.] 

FEASTS,  FESTIVALS,  or  HOLY- 
DAYS.  Among  the  earliest  means  adopted 
by  the  holy  Church  for  the  pm-pose  of 
impressing  on  the  minds  of  her  children 
the  mysterious  facts  of  the  gospel  history, 
was  the  appointment  of  a  train  of  anni- 
versaries and  holy  days,  with  appropriate 
services  commemorative  of  all  the  promi- 
nent transactions  of  the  Eedeemer's  life 
and  death,  and  of  the  labours  and  virtues 
of  the  blessed  apostles  and  evangelists. 

The  Church  begins  her  ecclesiastical  year 
with  the  Sundays  in  Advent,  to  remind  us 
of  the  coming  of  Christ  in  the  flesh.  After 
these,  we  are  brought  to  contemplate  the 
mystery  of  the  Incarnation;  and  so,  step 
by  step,  we  follow  the  Church  through  all 
the  events  of  our  Saviour's  pilgrimage,  to 
His  Ascension  into  heaven.  In  all  this  the 
grand  object  is  to  keep  Christ  perpetually 
before  us,  to  make  Him  and  His  doctrine 
the  chief  object  in  all  our  varied  services. 
Every  Sunday  has  its  peculiar  character, 
and  has  reference  to  some  act  or  scene  in 
the  life  of  our  Lord,  or  the  redemption, 
achieved  by  Him,  or  the  mystery  of  mercy 
carried  on  by  the  blessed  Trinity.  Thus 
every  year  brings  the  whole  gospel  history 
to  view ;  and  it  will  be  found  as  a  general 
rule,  that  the  appointed  portions  of  Scrip- 
ture, in  each  day's  service,  are  mutually 
illustrative;  the  New  Testament  casting 
light  on  the  Old,  prophecy  being  admirably 
brought  in  contact  with  its  accomplishment, 
so  that  no  plan  could  be  devised  for  a  more 
profitable  course  of  Scripture  reading  than 


FEASTS 

that  presented  by  the  Church  on  her  holy- 
days. 

The  festivals  ordered  to  be  observed  in 
the  Church  of  England  are :  "  All  Sundays 
in  the  year,  the  Circumcision  of  our  Lord 
Jesus  Christ,  the  Epiphany,  the  Conversion 
•of  St.  Paul,  the  Purification  of  the  Blessed 
Virgin,  St.  Matthias  the  Apostle,  the 
Annunciation  of  the  Blessed  Virgin,  St. 
Mark  the  Evangelist,  St.  Philip  and  St. 
James  the  Apostles,  the  Ascension  of  our 
Lord  Jesus  Chnst,  St.  Barnabas,  the  Nativ- 
ity of  St.  John  Baptist,  St.  Peter  the 
Apostle,  St.  James  the  Apostle,  St.  Barth- 
olomew the  Apostle,  St.  Matthew  the  Apos- 
tle, St.  Michael  and  all  Angels,  St.  Luke 
the  Evangelist,  St.  Simon  and  St.  Jude  the 
Apostles,  All  Saints,  St.  Andrew  the  Apos- 
tle, St.  Thomas  the  Apostle,  the  Nativity 
of  our  Lord,  St.  Stephen  the  Martyr,  St. 
John  the  Evangelist,  the  Holy  Innocents, 
Monday  and  Tuesday  in  Easter  week,  Mon- 
day and  Tuesday  in  Whitsun  week."  There 
-are  other  minor  festivals,  on  which  are  com- 
memorated certain  saints,  martyrs,  or  con- 
fessors who  lived  after  the  apostles'  time,  and 
which  are  called  "black  letter  days"  (See 
Sunday,  Saint  Days,  Slack  Letter  Days). 

Kubric  after  the  Nicene  Creed.  "The 
curate  shall  then  declare  to  the  people  what 
holy-days  or  fasting  days  are  in  the  week 
following  to  be  observed." 

Canon  64.  "  Every  parson,  vicar,  or 
curate  shall,  in  his  several  charge,  declare 
to  the  people  every  Sunday,  at  the  time 
appointed  in  the  communion  book,  whether 
there  be  any  holy-days  or  fasting  days,  the 
week  following.  And  if  any  do  hereafter 
xvittingly  offend  herein,  and  being  once 
admonished  thereof  by  his  ordinary,  shall 
again  omit  that  duty,  let  him  be  censured 
according  to  law,  until  he  submit  himself 
to  the  due  performance  of  it." 

Canon  13.  "All  manner  of  persons 
within  the  Church  of  England  shall  from 
henceforth  celebrate  and  keep  the  Lord's 
day,  commonly  called  Sunday,  and  other 
holy-days,  according  to  God's  will  and 
pleasure,  and  the  orders  of  the  Church  of 
England  prescribed  on  that  behalf;  that 
is,  in  hearing  the  word  of  God  read  and 
taught,  in  private  and  public  prayers,  in 
acknowledging  their  offences  to  God  and 
amendment  of  the  same,  in  reconciling 
themselves  charitably  to  their  neighbours 
where  displeasure  hath  been,  in  oftentimes 
receiving  the  communion  of  the  body  and 
blood  of  Christ,  in  visiting  of  the  poor  and 
sick,  using  all  godly  and  sober  conversation." 
In  the  Injunctions  of  King  Henry  VIIL, 
and  the  convocation  of  the  clergy,  a.d. 
1536,  it  was  ordered,  that  all  the  people 
might  freely  go  to  their  work  upon  all 
holidays  usually    before  kept,  which   fell 


PEEL4.L 


351 


either  in  the  time  of  harvest  (counted  from 
the  1st  day  of  July  to  the  29th  of  Sei> 
tember)  or  in  any  time  of  the  four  terms, 
when  the  king's  judges  sat  at  Westminster. 
But  these  holidays  (m  our  book  mentioned) 
are  specially  excepted,  and  commanded  to 
be  kept  holy  by  every  man. — Cosin's  Notes ; 
Hook's  Archbishops,  vol.  ix.  310. 

By  statute  5  &  6  Edward  VL  ch.  3,  it 
was  provided,  that  it  should  be  "  lawful  for 
every  husbandman,  labourer,  fisherman,  and 
every  other  person  of  what  estate,  degree, 
or  condition  they  be,  upon  the  holidays 
aforesaid,  in  harvest,  or  at  any  other  time 
in  the  year  when  necessity  shall  require,  to 
labour,  ride,  fish,  or  work  any  kind  of  work, 
at  their  free  wills  and  pleasure."  This  was 
repealed  by  Queen  Mary,  but  revived  by 
James  I.  Queen  Elizabeth,  in  the  mean- 
while, however,  declared  in  her  "injunc- 
tions," that  the  people  might  "  vrith  a  safe 
and  quiet  conscience,  after  their  common 
prayer,"  (which  was  then  at  an  early  hour,) 
"  in  the  time  of  harvest,  labour  upon  the 
holy  and  festival  days,  and  save  that  thing 
which  God  hath  sent "  (See  Calendar). 

The  moveable  feasts  are  those  which 
depend  upon  Easter,  and  consequently  do 
not  occur  on  the  same  day  every  year ; 
such  as  the  Sundays  after  the  Epiphany, 
Septuagesima  Sunday,  the  Sundays  of  Lent, 
Rogation  Sunday  (i.e.  the  Sunday  before  the 
Ascension),  Ascension  Day,  Whitsunday, 
Trinity  Sunday,  the  Sundays  after  Trinity, 
and  Corpus  Christi,  the  Thursday  in  Trinity 
week.  Advent  Sunday  is  the  nearest  to 
Nov.  30.     [H.] 

FELLOWSHIP.  An  establishment  in 
one  of  the  colleges  of  an  university,  or  in 
one  of  the  few  colleges  not  belonging  to 
universities,  with  a  share  of  its  revenues,  if 
any,  e.g.  King's  College,  London,  has  fellow- 
ships but  no  divisible  revenues.  And  there 
are  now  "  Honorary  Fellowships  "  in  the  two 
Universities.  Such  Fellows  are  no  part  of 
the  governing  body  of  the  college. 

FEEIAL.  According  to  the  derivation 
(feriss)  this  term  would  apply  only  to 
festival ;  but  in  the  Christian  Church  it  has 
been  used  from  early  times  to  denote  the 
days  of  the  week,  as  feria  secunda,  feria 
tertia  for  Monday,  Tuesday,  &c.  Tertullian 
uses  the  term  "feria  quarta,"  and  "feria 
sexta,"  for  Wednesday  and  Friday,  therefore 
it  cannot  have  originated,  as  has  been 
suggested,  from  the  emperor  Constantino 
appointing  the  week  following  Easter-day  to 
be  observed  as  a  continuous  festival,  giving 
each  day  the  festal  name  (Ducange,  Gloss.). 
The  use  of  the  word  probably  originated 
from  the  Sunday  being  called  the  Feria  and 
the  other  days  of  the  week  taking  their 
name  from  it,  as  the  2nd  day  from  Sunday 
(secunda  feria,  &c.).   Then  the  name  Domi- 


S52 


FEUILLANS 


iiioa  was  given  to  the  Sunday ;  but  the  old 
name  clung  to  the  week  daj's,  hence  they 
were  called  ferial  days,  as  distinguished  from 
the  Dominica  and  festival  days.     [H.] 

FEUILLANS.  A  congregation  of  monks, 
settled  towards  the  end  of  the  15th  century, 
by  John  de  la  Barriere ;  he  was  a  Cistercian, 
and  the  plan  of  his  new  congregation  was  a 
kind  of  a  reformation  of  that  order.  His 
method  of  refining  upon  the  old  constitution 
was  approved  of  by  Pope  Sixtus  V. ;  the 
Feuillantines  are  nuns,  who  followed  the 
same  reformation. 

FIFTH  MONARCHY  MEN  were  a  set 
of  enthusiasts  in  the  time  of  Cromwell,  who 
expected  the  sudden  appearance  of  Christ 
to  establish  on  earth  a  new  monarchy  or 
kingdom. 

FILIATION  OP  THE  SON  OP  GOD 
(See  Oeneration,  EternaV). 

FILIOQUE.  This  phrase,  which  involves 
the  doctrine  of  what  is  called  the  Double 
Procession  of  the  Holy  Ghost  was  inserted  in 
the  Creed  at  the  Council  of  Toledo  a.d.  589, 
and  became  one  of  the  main  causes  of  the 
great  schism  between  the  Eastern  and  the 
Western  Churches.  It  was  from  the  first 
adopted  generally  through  Gaul  and  Ger- 
many, and  was  upheld  by  Charles  the  Great, 
who  convoked  a  council  at  Aachen  in  809  to 
consider  it,  and  referred  the  question  for  the 
Papal  decision.  The  Pope  refused  to  sanc- 
tion it.  Afterwards  however  Pope  Nicho- 
las I.  insisted  on  its  insertion,  in  spite  of 
the  protests  of  the  Greeks,  and  the  rupture 
was  completed  when  on  July  16,  1054,  the 
legates  of  Pope  Leo  IX.  laid  on  the  altar  of 
St.  Sophia  at  Constantinople  a  \mt  of 
excommunication  against  Michael  Cerularius 
the  patriarch,  which  was  answered  by  an 
anathema  on  the  part  of  the  patriarch  and 
his  clergy.  The  Eastern  Church  objected  to 
the  phrase  on  two  groimds  :  (1)  that  it 
went  beyond  the  language  of  Scripture;  and 
(2)  that  it  was  not  sanctioned  by  a  general 
council.  The  controversy  has  been  kept  up 
to  the  present  time ;  but  in  the  Western 
Church  the  phrase  has  always  been  used; 
and  at  the  English  Reformation  the  question 
was  not  raised,  but  the  creed  remained  in 
accordance  with  the  Western  usage.     [H.] 

PINAL  APPEAL.  COURT  OF.  The 
Judicial  Committee  of  her  Majesty's  Privy 
Council  (See  Courts  Ecclesiastical). 

PINIAL,  (in  church  architecture,)  more 
anciently  Crop.  The  termination  of  a 
pinnacle,  spire,  pediment,  or  ogeed  hood- 
mould.  Originally  the  term  was  applied  to 
the  whole  pinnacle. 

FIRST  FRUITS.  In  the  earliest  times 
these  were  offerings  made  to  God,  and 
Origen  and  Irena'us  so  speak  of  them  (Orig. 
cent.  Cels.  lib.  viii.  p.  4,  &c. ;  Iren.  lib.  iv. 
c.  32).    Then  they  were  looked  upon  also 


FLAGELLANTS 

as  part  of  the  maintenance  of  the  clergy 
(Apost.  Const,  li.  c.  25 ;  viii.  c.  30,  Canon  4). 
And  as  the  clergy  were  to  the  Christians, 
as  the  Lovites  had  been  to  the  Jews,  so 
the  olfering  of  the  first  fruits  was  deemed 
obligatory  in  the  former  case  as  it  had  been 
in  the  latter  (St.  Jerome  on  Ezek.  xliv.- 
xlv. ;  Greg.  Naz.  Epist.  Ixxx.,  Oral.  15). 
But  in  the  middle  ages,  the  Pope,  claiming 
the  disposition  of  all  ecclesiastical  livings 
within  Christendom,  demanded  a  year's 
value  of  each  living,  under  the  name  of 
first  fmits.  This  was,  as  Blaokstone  says, 
"  a  part  of  the  usurpation  over  the  clergy  of 
these  kingdoms,  first  introduced  by  Pan- 
dulph,  the  Pope's  legate,  during  the  reigns 
of  John,  and  Henry  III.,  in  the  see  of  Nor- 
wich, and  afterwards  attempted  to  be 
made  universal  by  Pope  Clement  V.,  and 
John  XXII.  about  the  beginning  of  the 
14th  century. — PhUlimore's  Burn,  ii.  274. 

The  Pope  during  the  period  of  his  usur- 
pation over  our  Church,  bestowed  benefices 
of  the  Church  of  England  upon  foreigners, 
upon  condition  that  the  first  year's  pro- 
duce was  given  to  him,  for  the  regaining  of 
the  Holy  Land,  or  for  some  similar  pretence  : 
next,  he  prevailed  on  spiritual  patrons  to 
oblige  their  clergy  to  pay  them;  and  at 
last  he  claimed  and  extorted  them  from 
those  who  were  presented  by  the  king  or 
his  temporal  subjects.  The  first  Protestant 
king,  Henry  VHL,  took  the  first  fruits  from 
the  Pope,  but  instead  of  restoring  them  to 
the  Church,  vested  them  in  the  Crown. 
Queen  Anne  restored  them  to  the  Church, 
not  by  remitting  them  entirely,  but  by 
applying  these  superfluities  of  the  larger 
benefices  to  make  up  the  deficiencies  of  the 
smaller.  To  this  end  she  granted  her  royal 
charter,  whereby  all  the  revenue  of  first 
fruits  and  tenths  is  vested  in  trustees  for 
ever,  to  form  a  perpetual  fund  for  the  aug- 
mentation of  small  livings.  This  is  usually 
called  Queen  Anne's  Bounty  (See  Annates, 
and  Q.  A.  £.). 

FISTULA.  Also  called  canna,  calamus, 
siphon,  pipa,  &o.  A  tube  through  which 
it  was  at  one  time  ctistomary  to  suck  the 
wine  from  the  chalice  at  the  Holy  Eucharist. 
Its  use  arose  from  dread  lest  any  wine 
should  be  spilled.  It  is  still  retained  in 
solemn  Papal  celebrations  for  the  communion 
of  the  Pope.  In  the  Eastern  Church  a  spoon 
was  made  use  of  for  commimicating,  not  the 
fistula. — Diet.  Christ.  .Ant.  i.  675.     [H.] 

FIVE  POINTS  (see  Arminian  and 
Calvinism)  are  the  five  doctrines  contro- 
verted between  the  Arminians  and  Calvin- 
ists ;  relating  to,  1.  Particular  Election ;  2. 
Particular  Redemption;  3.  Moral  Inability 
in  a  Fallen  State;  4.  Irresistible  Grace; 
and  5.  Final  Perseverance  of  the  Saints. 

FLAGELLANTS.     A  name  given,  in 


FLAGOM 

the  13th  century,  to  a  sect  of  people  among 
the  Christians,  who  made  a  profession  of 
disciplining  themselves :  it  was  begun  in 
1260,  at  Perugia,  by  Eainerus,  a  hermit, 
who  exhorted  people  to  do  penance  for  their 
sins,  and  had  a  great  number  of  followers. 
In  1349,  they  spread  themselves  over  all 
Poland,  Germany,  France,  Italy,  and  Eng- 
land, carrying  a  cross  in  their  hands,  a  cowl 
upon  their  heads,  and  going  naked  to  the 
waist;  they  lashed  themselves  tmce  a  day, 
and  once  in  the  night,  mth  knotted  cords 
stuck  with  points  of  pins,  and  then  lay 
grovelling  upon  the  ground,  crying  out 
"  mercy : "  from  this  extravagance  they  fell 
into  a  gross  heresy,  affirming  that  their 
blood  united  in  such  a  manner  with  Christ's 
that  it  had  the  same  virtue;  that  after 
thirty  days'  whipping  they  were  acquitted 
from  the  guilt  and  punishment  of  sin,  so 
that  they  cared  not  for  the  sacraments. 
They  persuaded  the  common  people  that  the 
gospel  had  ceased,  and  allowed  all  sorts  of 
perjuries.  The  frenzy  lasted  a  long  time,  not- 
withstanding the  censures  of  the  Church,  and 
the  edicts  of  princes,  for  their  suppression. 

FLAGON.  A  vessel  used  to  contain  the 
wine,  before  and  at  the  consecration,  in  the 
Holy  Eucharist.  In  the  marginal  rubric  in 
the  prayer  of  consecration,  the  priest  is 
ordered  "  to  lay  his  hand  upon  every  vessel 
(be  it  chalice  or  flagon)  in  which  there  is 
any  wine  to  be  consecrated,"  but  in  the 
same  prayer  he  is  told  to  take  the  cup  only 
in  his  hand ;  and  the  rubric  before  the  form 
of  administering  the  cup  stands  thus,  "  the 
minister  that  delivereth  the  cup."  The 
distinction  then  between  the  flagon  and  the 
cup  or  chalice  is,  that  the  latter  is  the 
vessel  in  which  the  consecrated  wine  is  ad- 
ministered ;  the  flagon,  that  in  which  some 
of  the  wine  is  placed  for  consecration,  if 
there  be  more  than  one  vessel  used. 

FLORID  STYLE  OF  GOTHIC  AECHI- 
TECTURE.  The  later  division  of  the 
Perpendicular  style,  which  prevailed  chiefly 
during  the  Tudor  a;ra,  and  is  often  called 
the  Tudor  style. 

FLOWERS.  Adorning  with  flowers  is 
a  very  simple  and  most  innocent  method  of 
ornamenting  the  Christian  altar,  which  is 
enjoined  indeed  by  no  law,  but  which  is 
sanctioned  by  the  custom  of  some  churches 
in  this  kingdom,  in  which  also  the  Protes- 
tant churches  iu  Germany  agree.  This  way 
of  bringing  in  the  very  smallest  of  God's 
works  to  praise  Him  is  extremely  ancient, 
and  is  several  times  alluded  to  by  the 
Fathers ;  especiallv  by  St.  Jerome,  who 
thinks  it  worth  while  to  mention  in  the 
panegyric  of  his  friend  Nepotian,  that  his 
pious  care  for  the  Divine  worship  was  such 
that  be  made  flowers  of  many  kinds,  and 
the  leaves  of  trees,  and  the  branches  of  the 


FONT 


853 


vine,  contrioute  to  the  beauty  and  ornament 
of  the  church.  These  things,  says  St. 
Jerome,  were,  indeed,  but  trifling  in  them- 
selves ;  but  a  pious  mind,  devoted  to  Christ, 
is  intent  upon  small  things  as  well  as  great, 
and  neglects  nothing  that  pertains  even  to 
the  meanest  office  of  the  Church.  This 
custom  has  been  immemorially  observed  in 
some  English  churches.  It  has  also  been 
the  custom  in  some  places,  on  Easter  morn- 
ing, to  adorn  with  flowers  the  graves  of 
those  at  least  who  died  within  the  year. 

PONT  {Fans,  a  fountain).  The  largo 
basin,  or  vessel  which  holds  the  water  for 
baptism.  The  rites  of  baptism  in  the  first 
times  were  performed  in  fountains  and  rivers, 
both  because  the  converts  were  many,  and 
because  those  ages  were  unprovided  with 
other  baptisteries.  These  were  placed  at  first 
at  some  distance  from  the  church  (see  Bap- 
tistery), afterwards  in  the  church  porch,  and 
that  significantly,  because  baptism  is  the  en- 
trance into  the  Church  mystical,  as  the  porch 
of  the  temple.  At  last  fonts  were  intro- 
duced into  the  church  itself,  being  placed  at 
the  west  end,  near  the  south  entrance.  They 
were  not  admitted  in  the  first  instance  into 
every  church,  but  into  the  cathedral  of  the 
diocese,  thence  called  "  the  mother  church," 
because  it  gave  spiritual  birth  by  baptism. 
Afterwards  they  were  introduced  into  rural 
churches.  Wheresoever  they  stood,  they 
were  always  held  in  high  estimation  by  true 
Christians.  A  font  preserved  in  the  royal 
jewel-house,  and  formerly  used  for  the  bap- 
tism of  the  infants  of  the  royal  family,  )s 
of  silver.  In  England,  the  fonts  are  gene- 
rally placed  near  the  west  door,  or  south- 
western porch. 

By  the  Constitutions  of  Edmund,  a.d. 
1236,  there  was  to  be  "  a  font  of  stone  or 
other  competent  material  in  every  church, 
which  shall  be  decently  covered  and  kept, 
and  not  converted  to  other  uses.  And  the 
water  shall  not  be  kept  above  seven  days 
in  the  font "  (Linwood's  Constit). 

By  Canon  81.  "  According  to  a  former 
constitution,  too  much  neglected  in  many 
places,  there  shall  be  a  font  of  stone  in  every 
church  and  chapel  where  baptism  is  to  be 
ministered,  the  same  to  be  set  in  the  ancient 
usual  places ;  in  which  only  font  the  minister 
shall  baptize  publicly." 

"  When  there  are  children  to  be  baptized, 
the  parents  shall  give  knowledge  thereof 
over-night,  or  in  the  morning  before  the 
beginning  of  morning  prayer,  to  the  curate. 
And  then  the  godfathers  and  godmothers, 
and  the  people  with  the  children,  must  be 
ready  at  the  font,  either  immediaLely  after 
the  last  lesson  at  morning  prayer,  or  else 
immediately  after  the  last  lesson  at  evening 
prayer,  as  the  curate  by  his  discretion  shall 
appoint.     And  the  priest  coming  to  the  font 

2  A 


354 


FORMATS 


(which  is  then  to  be  filled  with  pure  water), 
and  standing  there,  shall  say." — Rubric  to 
the  Ministration  of  Public  Baptism  of 
Infants,  to  he  used  in  Church. 

In  which  rubric  it  may  be  observed,  that 
there  is  no  note  of  a  pewter,  crockery, 
wedgewood,  or  other  such  like  basin  within 
the  font,  to  hold  the  water,  which  the  care- 
lessness or  irreverence  of  some  has  permitted 
of  late ;  but  that  the  font  is  to  be  filled  with 
pure  water :  and  also  that  it  is  tlien  to  be 
filled,  and  not  just  at  the  convenience  of  the 
clerk  at  any  time  previous ;  the  like  rever- 
ence being  shown  herein  as  in  the  parallel 
order  about  the  elements  in  the  other  holy 
sacrament.  "  The  priest  shall  then  place 
upon  the  table,"  &o. 

"  And  if  they  shall  be  found  fit,  then  the 
godfathers  and  godmothers  (the  people  being 
assembled  upon  the  Sunday  or  holy-day 
appointed)  shall  be  ready  to  present  them 
at  the  font,  immediately  after  the  second 
lesson,  either  at  morning  or  evening  prayer, 
as  the  curate  in  his  discretion  shall  think 
fit." 

"  Then  shall  the  priest  take  each  person 
to  be  baptized  by  the  right  hand,  and  plac- 
ing him  conveniently  by  the  font,  according 
to  his  discretion,  shall  ask  the  godfathers 
and  godmothers  the  name  ?  and  then  shall 
dip  him  in  the  water,  or  pour  water  upon  him, 
saying."' — Eubrics  in  the  Ministration  of 
Baptism  to  such  as  are  of  Biper  Years. 

FOKMATiE  (See  Literx  Formatx). 

FORMS  OF  PBAYEE.,  for  Special 
Occasions.  Besides  the  great  festivals  and 
fasts  of  the  Church  universal,  there  will 
be,  in  each  Church,  continually  recurring 
occasions  of  thanksgiving  or  humihation, 
and  some  events  of  importance,  which  ought 
to  be  thus  celebrated,  and  for  wbicli  forms 
of  prayer  will  be  accordingly  appointed  by 
competent  authority.  The  days  thus  set 
apart  ia  the  Church  of  England  for  the 
celebration  of  great  events  in  our  liistory 
were  four :  the  5  th  of  November,  the  30  th 
of  January,  the  29th  of  May,  and  the  20th 
of  June;  but  of  these  the  first  three — the 
thanksgiving  for  deliverance  from  the  "  gim- 
powder  plot,"  the  day  of  fasting  "  in  com- 
memoration of  the  martyrdom  of  Charles  I.," 
and  the  thanksgiving  for  the  Eestoration, 
were  abolished  by  order  of  Council  in 
1859.  There  is  still  "  A  Form  of  Prayer 
with  Thanksgiving  to  Almighty  God,  to  be 
used  in  all  cliurches  and  chapels  within  this 
realm,  every  year,  upon  the  20th  day  of 
June,  being  the  day  on  which  her  Majesty 
began  her  happy  reign." 

When  passing  events,  such  as  a  pestilence, 
or  its  removal,  call  for  humiliation  or  thanks- 
giving, it  is  usual  for  the  Crown  to  require 
the  archbishop  of  Canterbury  to  prepare  a 
form  of  prayer  for  the  occasion,  which  is 


FORMULAEy 

then  sent  through  the  several  suffragan 
bishops  to  the  clergy  in  their  respective 
dioceses,  with  the  command  of  the  archbishop 
and  bishop  that  it  shall  be  used  on  certain 
fixed  days,  so  long  as  the  occasion  shall 
demand. 

But  it  is  not  very  clear  under  what  au- 
thority this  is  done,  except  long  usage,  which 
is  probably  sufficient  evidence  of  the  law  in 
such  a  matter.  Some  other  forms  of  prayer 
have  a  kind  of  general  recognition  ;  such  as 
the  Coronation  Service,  which  is  printed  in 
Phillimore's  Ecc.  Law :  the  usual  forms  of 
service  at  the  consecration  of  a  church,  or 
churchyard.  But  it  should  be  understood 
that  they  do  not  constitute  the  legal  con- 
secration, which  is  done  before  or  during 
the  service  by  the  bishop  accepting  the 
petition  and  signing  the  decree  for  consecra- 
tion, which  is  to  be  registered  in  the  registry 
of  the  diocese.  No  particular  form  of  that  is 
requisite  (See  Consecration^.  And  in  like 
manner  the  rehgious  service  is  optional  with 
the  bishop,  and  may  well  be  used  on  the 
reopening  of  a  church  after  rebuilding  on 
the  consecrated  ground,  though  the  legal 
ceremony  then  means  and  does  nothing,  and 
ought  not  to  be  used. 

The  Short  Services  Act  of  1872,  called  the 
Act  of  Uniformity  Amendment  Act,  author- 
ises the  bishop  to  allow  any  special  form  of 
service  approved  by  him  to  be  used  on  any 
special  occasion,  so  that  there  be  not  intro- 
duced anything  that  is  not  in  the  Bible  or 
the  Prayer  Book,  except  hymns  and  anthems 
(and  anthems  are  in  the  Bible).     [G-.] 

FORMULARY  (See  Common  Prayer, 
Liturgy).  A  book  containing  the  rites, 
ceremonies,  and  prescribed  forms  of  the 
Church.  The  formulary  of  the  Chm-ch  of 
England  is  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer. 

This  may  be  a  convenient  place  to  treat 
of  forms  of  prayer  generally. 

To  the  illustrious  divines  who  conducted 
the  reformation  of  our  Church,  in  the  reigns 
of  Henry,  Edward,  and  Elizabeth,  anj^ 
abstract  objections  to  a  prescribed  form  of 
prayer  seem  never  to  have  occurred,  for 
these  were  all  the  inventions  of  a  later 
period.  Ridiculous  it  would  be,  if  we  were 
going  to  address  a  human  sovereign,  to 
permit  one  of  our  number  to  utter  in  the 
royal  presence  any  unpremeditated  word.s, 
which  might  chance,  at  the  time  to  come 
into  his  head;  and  not  less  ridiculous, — 
if  it  be  allowai)le  to  use  such  an  expression 
under  such  circumstances, — would  they  have 
thought  it  to  permit  the  priest  to  offer  at 
the  footstool  of  the  King  of  kings,  a  petition 
in  the  name  of  the  Church,  of  which  the 
Church  had  no  previous  cognizance;  to 
require  the  people  to  say  "  Amen  "  to  prayers 
they  had  never  considered,  or  to  offer  as  joint 
prayers  what  they  had  never  agreed  to  offer. 


FOKJIULAET 

But,  as  has  been  observed,  it  was  not  upon 
the  abstract  question  that  they  were  called 
to  decide.  In  their  Church,  the  Church  of 
Kngland,  when  they  were  appointed  to  pre- 
side over  it,  they  found  prescribed  forms  of 
(irayer  in  use.  They  were  not  rash  innova- 
tors, who  thought  that  whatever  is  must  be 
^Troug ;  but,  on  the  contrary,  they  regarded 
the  fact  that  a  thing  was  already  established 
AS  an  argument  a  priori  in  its  favour ;  and 
therefore  they  would  only  have  inquired, 
whether  prescribed  forms  of  prayer  were 
•contrary  to  Scripture,  if  such  an  inquiry  had 
been  necessary.  We  say,  if  such  an  inquiry 
had  been  necessary,  because  the  slightest 
.acquaintance  with  Scripture  must  at  once 
have  convinced  them  that  contrary  to  Scrip- 
ture could  not  be  that  practice,  for  which 
we  can  plead  the  precedent  of  Moses  and 
Miriam,  and  the  daughters  of  Israel,  of  Aaron 
a,nd  his  sons  when  they  blessed  the  people, 
of  Deborah  and  Barak ;  when  the  practice 
was  even  more  directly  sanctioned  by  the 
Holy  Ghost  at  the  time  he  inspired  David 
.and  the  psalmists  ;  for  what  are  the  psalms 
but  an  inspired  fonn  of  prayer  for  the  use 
•of  the  Church  under  the  gospel,  as  well  as 
under  the  law  ?  The  services  of  the  syna- 
gogue, too,  it  is  well  known,  were  conducted 
.according  to  a  prescribed  form.  To  those 
.services  our  blessed  Lord  did  Himself  con- 
form :  and  severely  as  He  reproved  the  Jews 
for  their  departure,  in  various  particulars, 
■from  the  principles  of  their  fathers,  against 
their  practice  in  this  particular  never  did  He 
utter  one  word  of  censure ;  nay.  He  confirmed 
'the  practice,  when  He  Himself  gave  to  His 
■disciples  a  form  of  prayer,  and  framed  that 
prayer  too  on  the  model,  and  in  some  degree 
in  the  very  words,  of  prayers  then  in  use. 
-Our  Lord,  moreover,  when  giving  His  direc- 
tions to  the  rulers  of  His  Church,  at  the 
same  time  that  He  conferred  on  them  author- 
ity to  bind  and  to  loose,  directed  them  to 
.agree  touching  what  they  should  ask  for, 
which  seems  almost  to  convey  an  injunction 
to  the  rulers  of  every  particular  Church  to 
jjrovide  their  people  with  a  form  of  prayer. 

The  fact  that  we  find  this  injunction  in 
Scripture,  renders  probable  the  universal 
.tradition  of  the  universal  Church,  which 
traces  to  the  apostles,  or  apostolic  men,  the 
four  great  liturgies  (which  have,  in  all  parts 
■of  the  Church,  afforded  the  model  according 
to  which  all  others  have  been  framed),  and 
which  affirms  that  the  apostles  instituted  a 
form  of  worship  wherever  they  established  a 
•Church.  It  would  be  easy,  if  the  occasion 
required  it,  to  show,  from  a  variety  of  pas- 
sages in  holy  writ,  that  while  much  can  be 
adduced  in  coiToboration  of  this  tradition, 
^nothing  but  conjecture  can  be  cited  against 
it.  With  respect  to  those  passages  which, 
referring  prayer  to  the  influence  of  the  Holy 


FOEMULAIIY 


355 


Spirit  upon  the  soul  of  man,  are  sometimes 
brought  forward  as  militating  against  the 
adoption  of  a  form,  they  cannot  have  fallen 
under  the  notice  of  our  reformers,  since  the 
application  of  them  to  this  purpose  was 
never  dreamt  of  till  about  200  years  ago, 
when  men,  having  determined  in  their  wilful- 
ness to  reject  the  liturgy,  searched  for  every 
possible  authority  which  might,  by  construc- 
tions the  most  forced,  supjiort  their  deter- 
mination ;  and  the  new  interpretation  they 
thus  put  upon  Scripture  may  be  considered 
as  rather  the  plea  of  their  wishes  than  the 
verdict  of  their  conviction.  The  adduction, 
indeed,  of  such  passages  for  such  a  purpose 
is  a  gratuitous  assumption  of  the  question  in 
dispute,  and  ■\vi\l  not  for  a  moment  hold 
weight  in  the  balance  of  the  sanctuary. 
According  to  the  interpretation  of  those 
ancients,  whose  judgment  is  the  more  valu- 
able because  (living  before  any  controversy 
was  raised  on  the  subject)  they  were  little 
hkely  to  be  warped,  or  their  opinions  deter- 
mined, by  the  prejudices  of  sect,  or  the 
subtleties  of  system,  what  these  passages  of 
Scripture  mean  is  this,  and  simply  this  :  that 
the  Holy  Ghost,  who  Is  the  author  and  giver 
of  every  good  and  perfect  gift,  must  stir  up 
in  our  hearts  that  spirit  of  devotion  and 
holiness  of  temper,  without  which  the  ser- 
vice we  render  is  but  the  service  of  the  lips, 
and  is  useless,  if  not  profane. 

It  is,  then,  to  the  mind  with  which  we 
pray,  not  to  tlie  words  which  we  adopt, 
that  those  passages  of  Scripture  refer,  in 
which  we  are  exhorted  to  pray  in  the  Spirit. 
But  admitting,  for  the  sake  of  argument, 
that  where  we  are  told  that  the  Spirit  will 
teach  us  to  pray,  the  promise  is  applicable 
to  the  very  exjjresslons,  even  this  cannot  be 
produced  as  an  argument  against  a  form  of 
prayer.  For,  whatever  may  be  a  man's 
imaginary  gift  of  prayer,  this  is  quite  cer- 
tain, that  his  thoughts  must  precede  his 
tongue ;  that  before  he  speaks  he  must 
think.  And  not  less  clear  is  It,  that  after 
he  has  conceived  a  thought,  he  may,  for  a 
moment,  restrain  his  tongue,  and  set  down 
that  thought  upon  paper.  To  suppose  that 
the  intervention  of  the  materials  for  com- 
mitting his  thoughts  to  writing  must,  of 
necessity,  drive  away  the  Holy  Spirit, 
would  not  only  in  itself  be  absurd,  but  it 
would  be  tantamount  to  a  denial  of  the  in- 
spiration of  the  written  Scriptures.  If  the 
first  conceptions  were  of  God  and  God's 
Spirit,  then,  of  course,  they  are  so  still,  even 
after  they  have  been  written ; — the  mere 
writing  of  thern,  the  mere  committing  of 
them  to  paper,  can  have  nothing  whatever 
to  do  with  the  question  of  inspiration,  either 
one  way  or  the  other.  If  a  man,  therefore, 
asserts  that  his  extemporary  prayers  are  to 
be  attributed  to  the  Inspiration  of  the  Holy 

2  i.  2 


35G 


FOEMULARY 


Gliost,  we  can  at  once  reply  that  our  prayers, 
in  our  Prayer  Book,  are,  on  his  own  prin- 
ciples, quite  as  much  so,  with  this  further 
advantage,  that  tliey  have  been  carefully 
compared  with  Scripture,  and  tested  thereby. 
No  Scriptural  Christian,  no  one  not  mad 
with  folly,  will  contend  that,  on  that  ac- 
count, they  are  less  spiritual ;  though, 
on  the  other  hand,  we  may  fairly  doubt 
whether  an  extemporiser  is  not  acting  in 
direct  opposition  to  Scripture,  for  Scripture 
says  (Eccles.  v.  2),  "  Be  not  rash  with  thy 
mouth  to  utter  anything  before  Grod,  for  God 
is  in  heaven,  and  thou  upon  earth : "  and 
who  in  the  world  is  hasty  to  utter  anything 
before  God,  if  it  be  not  the  man  who.  prays 
to  him  extemporally  ? 

Again,  the  bishops  and  divines,  by  whom 
our  Church  was  reformed,  recognised  it  as 
the  duty  of  the  Church  to  excite  emotions 
of  solemnity  rather  than  of  enthusiasm, 
when,  she  leads  her  children  to  the  footstool 
of  that  throne  which,  if  a  throne  of  grace,  is 
also  a  throne  of  glory.  And,  therefore, 
when  discarding  those  ceremonies  which, 
not  of  primitive  usage,  had  been  abused,  and 
might  be  abused  again,  to  the  purposes  of 
supnrstition,  they  still  made  ample  pro- 
visiov  that  the  services  of  the  sanctuary 
should  be  conducted  with  decent  ceremony, 
and  orderly  form,,  and  impressive  solemnity, 
and  in  our  cathedrals  and  the  royal  chapels 
with  magnificence  and  grandeur.  They 
sought  not  to  annihilate ;  they  received 
with  the  profoundest  respect  those  ancient 
ceremonials  and  forms  of  prayer  which  had 
been  used  in  their  Church  from  the  first 
planting  of  Christianity  in  this  island. 
These  ancient  forms,  however,  had  been 
used  in  many  respects,  though  gradually 
corrupted.  In  everj^  age,  men  had  made  the 
attempt  to  render  them  more  and  more  con- 
formable to  the  spirit  of  the  age,  and  (in 
ages  of  darkness)  superstitions  in  practice, 
and  novelties,  and  therefore  errors  in  doctrine, 
had  crept  in.  Our  wise-hearted  refonners, 
intent,  not  on  pleasing  the  people,  nor  re- 
gaining popularity,  nor  on  consulting  the 
spirit  of  the  age,  but  simply  and  solely  on 
ascertaining  and  maintaining  the  truth  as  it 
is  in  Jesus,  having  obtained  a  coromission 
from  the  Crown,  first  of  all  compared  the 
existing  forms  of  worship  ■\vith  the  inspired 
word  of  God,  being  determined  at  once 
to  reject  what  was  plainly  and  palpably 
at  variance  therewith.  For  example,  the 
prayers  before  the  Reformation  had  been 
offered  in  the  Latin  language,  a  language  no 
longer  intelligible  to  the  mass  of  the  people, 
but  to  pray  in  a  tongue  not  understood  by 
the  people,  is  plainly  and  palpably  at  variance 
with  Scripture  ;  and,  consequent!}',  the  first 
thing  they  did  was  to  have  the  liturgy 
translated  into  English.     Having  taken  care 


FRANCISCANS 

that  nothing  should  remain  in  the  forms  of 
worship  contrary  to  Scripture,  they  pro- 
ceeded (by  comparing  them  with  the  most 
ancient  rituals)  to  renounce  all  usages  not 
clearly  primitive  ;  and,  diligently  consulting 
the  works  of  the  Fathers,  they  embodied  the 
doctrines  universally  received  by  the  early 
Church  in  that  book  which  was  the  result 
and  glory  of  their  labours,  the  Book  of 
Common  Prayer.  The  work  of  these  com- 
missioned divines  was  submitted  to  the 
convocations  of  the  other  bishops  and  clergy, 
and  being  approved  by  them,  and  authoiised 
by  the  Crown,  was  laid  before  the  two  houses 
of  parliament,  and  was  accepted  by  the 
laity,  who  respectfully  thanked  the  bishops 
for  their  labour.  And  thus  it  is  seen,  that 
the  English  Prayer  Book  was  not  composed 
in  a  few  years,  or  by  a  few  men ;  it  has 
descended  to  us  from  the  first  ages  of 
Christianity.  It  has  been  shown  by  Palmer 
(Orig.  Liturg.)  that  there  is  scarcely  a  por- 
tion of  our  Prayer  Book  which  cannot,  in 
some  way,  be  traced  to  ancient  offices.  And 
this  it  is  important  to  note ;  first,  because  it 
shows  that  as  the  Papist  in  England  is  not 
justified  in  calling  his  the  old  Church,  since 
ours  is  the  old  Church  reformed,  his  a  sect, 
in  this  country,  comparatively  new ;  so- 
neither  may  he  produce  his  in  opposition 
to  ours  as  the  old  liturgy.  All  that  is  really 
ancient  we  retained,  when  the  bishops  and 
divines  who  reformed  our  old  Church  cor- 
rected, from  Scripture  and  antiquity,  our 
old  liturgy.  What  they  rejected,  and  the 
Papists  adhered  to,  were  innovations  and 
novelties  introduced  during  the  middle 
ages.  And  it  is  important  to  observe  this, 
in  the  next  place,  since  it  is  this  fact 
which  constitutes  the  value  of  the  Prayer 
Book,  regarded,  as  we  do  regard  it,  not  only 
as  a  manual  of  devotion,  but  also  as  an 
interpreter  of  Scriptiu'e.  It  embodies  the 
doctrines  and  observances  which  the  earlj'' 
Christians  (having  received  them  from  the 
apostles  themselves)  preserved  with  re- 
verential care,  and  handed  down  as  a  sacred 
deposit  to  their  posterity. 

FRANCISCANS,  or  MINORITES 
(Fratres  Minores,  as  they  were  called  by 
their  founder).  I.  An  order  of  friars- 
in  the  Romish  Church,  and  so  denominated 
from  St.  Francis,  their  first  founder  in 
1206,  who  prescribed  the  following  rules 
to  them :  That  the  rule  and  life  of  the 
brother  minors  (for  so  he  would  have  those 
of  his  order  called)  was  to  observe  the  gospel 
under  obedience,  possessing  nothing  as  their 
own,  and  to  live  in  charity  ;  then  he  showed 
how  they  should  receive  novices  after  a 
year's  noviciate,  after  which  it  was  not 
allowed  i\\m\  to  leave  the  order ;  he  would 
have  his  friars  make  use  of  the  Roman 
breviaiy,  and  the  convei'ts  or  lay-brethren 


FEANOISCANS 

to  recite  every  day,  for  tlieir  office,  seventy- 
six  Paternosters  ;  besides  Lent,  lie  ordered 
them  to  fast  from  All-saints  to  Christmas, 
iind  to  begin  Lent  on  twelfth-tide;  he  forbade 
them  to  ride  on  horseback  without  some 
urgent  necessity ;  and  would  have  them  in 
their  journeys  to  eat  of  whatsoever  was  laid 
before  them  :  they  were  to  receive  no  money, 
either  directly  or  indirectly ;  he  taught  them 
that  they  should  get  their  livelihood  by  the 
labour  of  their  hands,  receiving  for  it  any- 
thing but  money ;  that  they  ought  to  possess 
nothing  of  their  own,  and  when  their  labour 
was  not  sufficient  to  maintain  them,  they 
ought  to  go  a-begging,  and,  with  the  alms 
so  collected,  to  help  one  another ;  that  they 
ought  to  confess  to  their  provincial  ministers 
those  sins,  the  absolution  of  which  was  re- 
served to  them,  that  they  might  receive  from 
them  charitable  corrections ;  that  the  elec- 
tion of  their  general  ministers,  superiors,  &c., 
ought  to  be  in  a  general  assembly;  that 
they  ought  not  to  preach  without  leave  of 
the  ordinaries  of  each  diocese,  and  of  tlieir 
superiors.  Then  he  prescribed  the  manner 
of  admonition  and  correction;  that  they 
ought  not  to  enter  into  any  nunnery,  to  be 
godfathers  to  any  child,  nor  to  undertake  to 
go  into  any  foreign  countries  to  convert  in- 
fidels, without  leave  of  their  provincial 
ministers ;  and  then  he  bids  them  ask  of  the 
pope  a  cardinal  for  governor,  protector,  and 
corrector  of  the  whole  order. 

Francis,  their  founder,  was  bom  in  1182, 
at  Assisi,  in  the  province  of  Umbria,  in 
Italy,  of  noble  parentage,  but  much  more  re- 
nowned for  his  holy  life.  His  baptismal 
name  was  John,  but  he  assumed  that  of 
Francis,  from  having  learnt  the  French  lan- 
guage. He  renounced  a  considerable  estate, 
with  all  the  pleasures  of  the  world,  to 
embrace  a  voluntary  poverty,  and  live  in 
the  practice  of  the  greatest  austerities. 
Going  barefoot,  and  embracing  an  apostolical 
life,  he  performed  the  office  of  preacher  on 
Sundays  and  other  fe.stivals,  in  the  parish 
•churches.  In  the  year  1206,  or  1209,  de- 
signing to  establish  a  religious  order,  he 
presented  to  Pope  Innocent  III.  a  copy  of 
the  rules  he  had  conceived,  praying  that  his 
institute  might  be  confirmed  by  the  holy 
see.  The  pope,  considering  his  despicable 
appearance,  and  the  extreme  rigour  of  his 
rules,  bid  him  go  find  out  swine,  and  deliver 
them  the  rule  he  had  composed,  as  being 
fitter  for  such  animals  than  for  men.  Francis, 
being  withdrawn,  went  and  rolled  himself  in 
the  mire  with  some  swine,  and,  in  that  filthy 
condition,  again  presented  himself  before  the 
pope,  beseeching  him  to  grant  his  request. 
The  pope,  moved  hereby,  granted  his  peti- 
tion, and  confirmed  his  order. 

From  this  time  Francis  became  famous 
throughout  all  Italy,  and  many  persons  of 


FEANCISCANS 


357 


birth,  following  his  example,  forsook  the 
world,  and  put  themselves  under  his  di- 
rection. Thus  this  order  of  friars,  called 
Minors,  spread  all  over  Europe ;  who,  living 
in  cities  and  towns,  by  tens  and  sevens, 
preached  in  the  villages  and  parish  churches, 
and  instructed  the  rude  country  people. 
Some  of  them  likewise  went  among  the 
Saracens,  and  into  Pagan  countries,  where 
many  obtained  the  crown  of  martyrdom. 
I-i'rancis  died  at  Assisi  in  1226.  He  never 
received  higher  orders  than  the  diaconate. 

It  is  pretended  that,  a  little  before  the 
death  of  St.  Francis,  there  appeared  wounds 
in  his  hands  and  feet,  like  those  of  our 
Saviour,  continually  bleeding,  of  which, 
after  his  death,  there  appeared  not  the 
least  token.  He  was  buried  in  his  own 
oratory  at  Rome,  and  his  name  was  inserted 
in  the  catalogue  of  saints. 

II.  The  fii-st  monastery  of  this  order  was 
at  Assisi,  in  Italy,  where  the  Benedictines  of 
that  place  gave  St.  Francis  the  church  of 
St.  Mary,  called  Portiuncula.  Soon  after, 
convents  were  erected  in  other  places ;  and 
afterwards  St.  Francis  founded  others  in 
Spain  and  Portugal.  In  the  year  1215, 
this  order  was  approved  in  the  general 
Lateran  council.  Then  St.  Francis,  re- 
turning to  Assisi,  held  a  general  chapter, 
and  sent  missions  into  France,  Germany, 
England,  and  other  parts.  This  order  made 
so  great  a  progress  in  a  short  time,  that, 
at  the  general  chapter  held  at  Assisi,  in 
1219,  there  met  5000  friars,  who  were  only 
deputies  from  a  much  greater  number. 
There  were  in  the  middle  of  the  last  cen- 
tury above  7000  houses  of  this  order,  and 
in  them  above  115,000  monks :  there  were 
also  above  900  monasteries  of  Franciscan 
nuns.  This  order  has  produced  four  popes, 
forty-five  cardinals,  and  an  infinite  number 
of  patriarchs,  archbishops,  and  two  electors 
of  the  empire ;  besides  a  great  number  of 
learned  men  and  missionaries. 

III.  The  Franciscans  came  into  England 
during  the  life  of  their  founder,  in  the 
reign  of  King  Henry  III.  Their  first  estab- 
lishment was  at  Canterbury.  They  zeal- 
ously opposed  King  Henry  VIII.  in  the 
affair  of  his  divorce ;  for  which  reason,  at 
the  suppression  of  the  monasteries,  they 
were  expelled  before  all  others,  and  above 
200  of  them  thrown  into  gaols ;  thirty-two 
of  them  coupled  in  chains  like  dogs,  and 
sent  to  distant  prisons;  others  banished, 
and  others  condemned  to  death.  Whilst 
this  order  flourished  in  England,  they 
divided  the  kingdom  into  seven  parts  or 
districts,  called  custodies,  because  each  of 
them  was  governed  by  a  provincial,  or 
superior,  called  the  ctistos,  or  guardian  of 
the  district.  The  seven  custodies  were, 
that  of  London,  consisting  of  nine  monas- 


358 


FEANK  ALMOIGNE 


teries;  that  of  York,  consisting  of  seven 
monasteries ;  that  of  Cambridge,  contain- 
ing nine  monasteries ;  tliat  of  Bristol,  con- 
taining nine  monasteries ;  that  of  Oxford, 
in  which  were  eiglit  monasteries ;  that  of 
Newcastle,  in  which  were  nine  monasteries ; 
and  that  of  Worcester,  in  whicli  were  nine 
monasteries;  in  all,  sixty  monasteries. 

Tlie  iirst  establishment  of  Franciscans 
in  London  was  begmi  by  four  friars,  who 
hired  for  themselves  a  certain  house  in 
Cornhill,  of  John  Travers,  then  sheriff  of 
London,  and  made  it  into  little  cells ; 
wlaere  they  lived  till  the  summer  following, 
when  they  were  removed,  by  John  Iwyn, 
citizen  and  mercer  of  London,  to  the  parish 
of  St.  Nicliolas  in  the  Shambles.  There  he 
assigned  them  land  for  the  building  of  a 
monastery,  and  entered  himself  into  the 
order. 

PKANK  ALMOIGNE.  "  Tenant  in  frank 
almoigne  is  when  an  abbot  or  prior,  or  other 
man  of  religion,  or  of  holy  Church,  holdeth  of 
his  lord  in  frank  almoigne ;  that  is  to  say  in 
Latine  in  liberam  eleemosinam,  that  is  '  in 
free  almes.'  And  such  tenure  beganne  first  in 
oldetime.  Whenamanin  oldetimewasseized 
of  certain  lands  or  tenements  in  his  demesne 
as  of  fee,  and  of  the  same  land  infeoffed  an 
abbot  or  his  convent,  or  prior,  and  his  con- 
vent, to  have  and  to  hold  them,  and  their 
successors  in  pure  and  perpetual  almes,  or  in 
frank  almoigne  ;  or  by  such  words,  to  hold 
of  the  grantor,  or  of  the  lesser  and  his  heirs, 
in  free  almes;  in  such  case  the  tenements 
were  holden  in  frank  almoigne"  (Littleton, 
sec.  133).  On  this  Coke  says, "  Since  Little- 
ton wrote,  the  liturgie  or  boolv  of  Common 
Praier  of  celebrating  Divine  service  is  altered. 
This  alteration  notwithstanding,  yet  the 
tenure  in  frank  almoigne  remaineth;  and 
such  prayers  and  divine  service,  shall  be 
said  and  celebrated  as  now  is  authorized." 
"  And  albeit  the  tenure  in  frank  almoigne 
is  now  reduced  to  a  certaintie,  contained  in 
the  book  of  Common  Prayer,  yet  seeing  the 
original  tenure  was  in  franls  almoigne,  and 
the  change  is  by  generall  consent  by 
authority  of  Parliament  (2  Ed.  VL  c.  1 ; 
5  &  6  Ed.  VI.  c.  11 ;  1  Eliz.  c.  2),  whereunto 
every  man  is  party,  the  tenure  remains 
as  it  was  before "  (Coke,  s.  135).  The 
statute  12  Car.  II.,  which  abolishes  military 
tenure,  expressly  excepts  tenure  in  frank 
almoigne.     [H.] 

FEATERNITIES.  Brotherhoods  or 
societies  generally  for  the  improvement  of 
devotion.  Monasteries  are  really  fraterni- 
ties ;  but  besides  them,  either  connected 
with  them  or  entirely  separate,  there  have 
always  been  associations  called  by  this  name. 
The  Parabolani  and  Copiata;  (which  see)  of 
the  early  Church  were  sometimes  considered 
members  of  a  fraternity  (^Muratori  aut  Med. 


FREE  WILL 

JEvi.  vol.  vi.) ;  and  that  there  were  many 
unauthorized  associations  is  evident  froia 
the  fact  that  at  the  Council  of  Chalcedon 
clerics  were  forbidden  to  form  "  o-vvaiio- 
crias  rj  ippaTpias."  In  the  8th  and  9th 
centuries  there  were  Anglo-Saxon  fraterni- 
ties of  a  lay  constitution  but  of  a  more 
or  less  religious  character  (Brentano  mi 
Gilds,  p.  11  seq.).  In  the  Eoman  Church 
there  are  many,  the  most  celebrated  perhaps 
being  the  fraternity  of  the  Kosary,  estab- 
lished by  Dominic.  Guilds  and  firatemities 
are  synonymous  terms,  the  former  being 
generally  used  in  England  at  present  (See 
Guilds). 

FBATRIOBLLI.  Fratres  de  paupere 
vita.  Little  Brothers.  Certain  fanatics  of 
Italy,  who  had  their  rise  in  the  Marquisate 
of  Ancona  about  1294.  They  were  monks- 
who  had  detached  themselves  from  the 
Franciscans,  but  still  professed  to  follow 
the  Franciscan  rule.  But  the  accounts  of 
them  are  confused  and  contradictory,  prob- 
ably because  the  term  "  fratricellus  "  (little 
brother)  was  a  term  of  reproach  among  the 
Italians  of  that  age,  and  was  applied  to  any 
one  who  assumed  the  appearance  of  a  monk 
without  belonging  to  the  approved  monastic 
sects.  Pope  John  XXII.  condemned  the 
Fratricelli  in  a  Bull  a.d.  1317. — Wadding. 
Annates  Minorum,  vi.  279 ;  Stubbs'  Mos- 
heim,  ii.  206  ;  Gieseler,  iii.  92. 

FREEMASONS.  An  ancient  guild  of 
architects,  to  whom  church  architecture 
owes  much,  and  to  whom  is  to  be  attributed 
a  great  part  of  the  beauty  and  uniformitj- 
of  the  ecclesiastical  edifices  of  tlie  several 
well-marked  architectural  eras  of  the  mid- 
dle ages. 

The  Freemasons  at  present  arrogate  to 
themselves  a  monstrous  antiquity;  it  is- 
certain,  however,  that  they  were  in  exist- 
ence early  in  the  tenth  century,  and  that 
before  the  close  of  tliat  century  they  had. 
been  formally  incorporated  by  the  pope, 
with  many  exclusive  privileges.  But  the 
Eoman  Church  now  disavows  and  prohibits 
them.  The  society  consisted  of  persons  of 
all  nations  and  of  every  rank ;  and  being 
strictly  an  ecclesiastical  society,  the  tone  of 
the  architecture  to  which  they  gave  their 
study  became  distinctively  theological  and 
significant.  The  principal  ecclesiastics  of 
the  day  were  ranked  among  its  members, 
and  probably  many  of  its  clerical  brethreix 
were  actually  and  actively  engaged  in  its 
practical  operations.  In  the  present  day,  it 
is  quite  certain  that  freemasons  have  no- 
special  knowledge  of  architecture,  or  of 
anything  else  except  their  secret  signs  of 
brotherhood  of  difi'erent  degrees. 

FEEE  WILL.  Since  the  introduotioa 
of  Calvinism,  many  persons  have  been  led 
into  perplexity  on  this  subject,  by  not  sufii- 


FREE  WILL 

ciently  distinguishing  between  the  free  will 
of  spontaneous  mental  preference,  and  the 
good  will  of  freely  preferring  virtue  to  vice. 

By  the  ancients,  on  the  contrary,  who 
were  frequently  called  upon  to  oppose  the 
mischievous  impiety  of  fatalism,  while  yet 
they  stood  pledged  to  maintain  the  vital 
doctrine  of  Divine  grace,  this  distinction 
was  well  known  and  carefully  observed. 

The  Manicha3ans  so  denied  free  will,  as  to 
hold  a  fatal  necessity  of  sinning,  whether 
the  choice  of  the  individual  did  or  did  not 
go  along  with  the  action. 

The  Pelagians  so  held  free  will,  as  to 
deny  the  need  of  Divine  grace  to  make  that 
free  will  a  good  will. 

By  the  Catholics,  each  of  these  systems 
was  alike  rejected.  They  held,  that  man 
possesses  free  will ;  for,  otherwise,  he  could 
not  be  an  accountable  subject  of  God's 
moral  goverimient.  But  they  also  held, 
that,  in  consequence  of  the  fall,  his  free  will 
was  a  bad  will :  whence,  with  a  perfect 
conscious  freedom  of  choice  or  preference, 
and  without  any  violence  put  upon  his 
inclination,  he,  perpetually,  though  quite 
spontaneously,  prefers  unholiness  to  holi- 
ness ;  and  thus  requires  the  aid  of  Divine 
grace  to  make  his  bad  will  a  good  will. 

The  reader  may  see  this  point  established 
by  quotations  from  the  Fathers  in  Faber's 
work  on  "  Election,"  from  which  this  article 
is  taken.  He  shows  also  that  the  doctrine 
taught  by  Augustine  and  the  ancients  is 
precisely  that  which  is  maintained  by  the 
reformers  of  our  Anglican  Church. 

Those  venerable  and  well-informed  mo- 
derns resolve  not  our  evil  actions  into  the 
compulsory  fatal  necessity  of  Manichasism, 
on  the  one  hand ;  nor,  on  the  other  hand, 
according  to  the  presumptuous  scheme  of 
Pelagianism,  do  they  claim  for  us  a  spon- 
taneous choice  or  preference  of  good  inde- 
pendently of  the  Divine  assistance. 

The  simple  freedom  of  man's  will,  so  that, 
whatever  he  chooses,  he  chooses  not  against 
his  inclination,  but  through  a  direct  and 
conscious  internal  preference  of  the  thing 
chosen  to  the  thing  rejected :  this  simple 
freedom  of  man's  will  they  deny  not. 

But,  while  they  acknowledge  the  simple 
freedom  of  man's  will,  they  assert  the 
quality  of  its  choice  or  preference  to  be  so 
perverted  by  the  fall,  and  to  be  so  distorted 
by  the  influence  of  original  sin,  that,  in 
order  to  his  choosing  the  good  and  rejecting 
the  evil,  the  grace  of  God,  by  Christ,  must 
both  make  his  bad  wiU  a  good  will,  and 
must  also  still  continue  to  co-operate  with 
him  even  when  that  goodness  of  the  will 
shall  have  been  happily  obtained. 

In  the  tenth  Article  of  the  English 
Church,  it  is  often  not  sufficiently  observed, 
that  our  minutely  accurate  reformers  do  not 


FUNERAL  SERVICES 


359 


say,  that  the  grace  of  God,  in  the  work  of 
conversion,  gives  us  free  will,  as  if  we  were 
previously  subject  to  a  fatal  necessity ;  but 
only  that  the  grace  of  God,  by  Christ, 
prevents  us  that  we  may  have  a  good  will, 
and  co-ojierates  with  us  when  we  have  that 
good  will. 

The  doctrine,  in  short,  of  the  English 
Church,  when  she  declares  that  fallen  man 
cannot  turn  and  prepare  himself,  by  his 
own  natural  strength  and  good  works,  to 
faith  and  calling  upon  God,  is  not  that  we 
really  prefer  the  spiritual  life  to  the  animal 
life,  and  are  at  the  same  time  by  a  fatal 
necessity  prevented  from  embracing  it ;  but 
it  is  that  we  prefer  the  animal  life  to  the 
spiritual  life,  and  through  the  badness  of 
our  perverse  will,  shall  continue  to  prefer  it, 
until  (as  the  Article  speaks)  the  grace  of 
God  shall  prevent  us  that  we  may  have  a 
good  will,  or  until  (as  Holy  Scripture 
speaks)  the  people  of  the  Lord  shall  be 
willing  in  the  day  of  his  power. 

FEIAR  (From/raier,  brother).  A  term 
common  to  monks  of  all  orders  :  founded  on 
this,  that  there  is  a  kind  of  brotherhood 
presumed  between  the  religious  persons  of 
the  same  monastery.  It  is  however  com- 
monly confined  to  monks  of  the  mendicant 
orders.  Friars  are  generally  distinguished 
into  these  four  principal  branches : — 1. 
Franciscans,  Minors,  or  Grey  Friars ;  2. 
Augustines ;  3.  Dominicans,  or  Black  Friars ; 
4.  Carmelites,  or  White  Friars.  From  these 
four  the  rest  of  the  orders  in  the  Roman 
Church  descend.  In  a  more  particular  sense 
the  term  Friar  is  applied  to  such  monks 
as  are  not  priests ;  for  those  in  orders  are  usu- 
ally dignified  with  the  appellation  of  Father. 

FRIDAY.  Friday  was,  both  in  the 
Greek  Church  and  Latin,  a  Litany  or  hu- 
miliation 6  ay,  in  memory  of  Christ  crucified : 
and  so  is  kept  in  ours.  It  is  our  weekly  fast 
for  our  share  in  the  death  of  Christ,  and  its 
gloom  is  only  dispersed  if  Christmas  day 
happens  to  fall  thereon  (See  Stations ;  Week- 
days). 

FRONTAL.  The  antependium  or  vest- 
ment that  hangs  around  and  in  front  of  the 

FUNERAL  SERVICES  (See  Burial  of 
the  Bead,  and  Dead).  The  office  which  the 
EngUsh  Church  appoints  to  be  used  at  the 
burial  of  the  dead  is,  like  all  her  other  offices, 
of  most  ancient  date,  having  been  used  by 
the  Church  in  the  East  and  the  West  from 
the  remotest  antiquity,  and  having  been 
only  translated  into  English  by  the  bishops 
and  divines  who  reformed  our  Church.  But 
against  this  office,  as  against  others,  objec- 
tions have  been  raised ;  chiefly  against  saying 
that  we  commit  our  brother's  "  body  to  the 
ground,  earth  to  earth,  ashes  to  ashes,  dust 
to  dust,   in   sure  and  certain  hope  of  the 


FREE  WILL 

ciently  distinguishing  between  the  free  will 
of  spontaneous  mental  preference,  and  the 
good  will  of  freely  prefeiTing  virtue  to  vice. 

By  the  ancients,  on  the  contrary,  who 
were  frequently  called  upon  to  oppose  the 
mischievous  impiety  of  fatalism,  while  yet 
they  stood  pledged  to  maintain  the  vital 
doctrine  of  Divine  grace,  this  distinction 
was  well  known  and  carefully  observed. 

'J'he  Manichseans  so  denied  free  will,  as  to 
hold  a  fatal  necessity  of  sinning,  whether 
the  choice  of  the  individual  did  or  did  not 
go  along  with  the  action. 

The  Pelagians  so  held  free  will,  as  to 
deny  the  need  of  Divine  grace  to  make  that 
free  will  a  good  will. 

By  the  (Jatholics,  each  of  these  systems 
was  alike  rejected.  They  held,  that  man 
possesses  free  will ;  for,  otherwise,  he  could 
not  be  an  accountable  subject  of  God's 
moral  govermnent.  But  they  also  held, 
that,  in  consequence  of  the  fall,  his  free  will 
was  a  bad  will :  whence,  with  a  perfect 
conscious  freedom  of  choice  or  preference, 
and  without  any  violence  put  upon  his 
inclination,  he,  perpetually,  though  quite 
spontaneously,  prefers  unholiness  to  holi- 
ness ;  and  thus  requires  the  aid  of  Divine 
grace  to  make  his  bad  will  a  good  will. 

The  reader  may  see  this  point  established 
by  quotations  from  the  Fathers  in  Faber's 
work  on  "  Election,"  from  which  this  article 
is  taken.  He  shows  also  that  the  doctrine 
taught  by  Augustine  and  the  ancients  is 
precisely  that  which  is  maintained  by  the 
reformers  of  our  Anglican  Church. 

Those  venerable  and  well-informed  mo- 
derns resolve  not  our  evil  actions  into  the 
compulsory  fatal  necessity  of  Manicha^ism, 
on  the  one  hand ;  nor,  on  the  other  hand, 
according  to  the  presumptuous  scheme  of 
Pelagianism,  do  they  claim  for  us  a  spon- 
taneous choice  or  preference  of  good  inde- 
pendently of  the  Divine  assistance. 

The  simple  freedom  of  man's  will,  so  that, 
whatever  he  chooses,  he  chooses  not  against 
his  inclination,  but  through  a  direct  and 
conscious  internal  preference  of  the  thing 
chosen  to  the  thing  rejected:  this  simple 
freedom  of  man's  will  they  deny  not. 

But,  while  they  acknowledge  the  simple 
freedom  of  man's  wUl,  they  assert  the 
quality  of  its  choice  or  preference  to  be  so 
perverted  by  the  fall,  and  to  be  so  distorted 
by  the  influence  of  original  sin,  that,  in 
order  to  his  choosing  the  good  and  rejecting 
the  evU,  the  grace  of  God,  by  Christ,  must 
both  make  his  bad  will  a  good  will,  and 
must  also  still  continue  to  co-operate  with 
him  even  when  that  goodness  of  the  will 
shall  have  been  happily  obtained. 

In  the  tenth  Article  of  the  English 
Church,  it  is  often  not  sufficiently  observed, 
that  our  minutely  accurate  reformers  do  not 


FUNERAL  SERVICES 


359 


say,  that  the  grace  of  God,  in  the  work  of 
conversion,  givef5  us  free  will,  as  if  we  were 
previously  subject  to  a  fatal  necessity ;  but 
only  that  the  grace  of  God,  by  Christ, 
prevents  us  that  we  may  have  a  good  will, 
and  co-operates  with  us  when  we  have  that 
good  will. 

The  doctrine,  in  short,  of  the  English 
Church,  when  she  declares  that  fallen  man 
cannot  turn  and  prepare  himself,  by  his 
own  natural  strength  and  good  works,  to 
faith  and  calling  upon  God,  is  not  that  we 
really  prefer  the  spiritual  life  to  the  animal 
life,  and  are  at  the  same  time  by  a  fatal 
necessity  prevented  from  embracing  it ;  but 
it  is  that  we  prefer  the  animal  life  to  the 
spii'itual  life,  and  through  the  badness  of 
otir  perverse  ivill,  shall  continue  to  prefer  it, 
until  (as  the  Article  speaks)  the  grace  of 
God  shall  prevent  us  that  we  may  have  a 
good  ^\^ll,  or  until  (as  Holy  Scripture 
speaks)  the  jjeople  of  the  Lord  shall  be 
v/illing  in  the  day  of  his  power. 

FEIAR  (Yromf rater,  brother).  A  term 
common  to  monks  of  all  orders  :  founded  on 
this,  that  there  is  a  kind  of  brotherhood 
presumed  between  the  religious  persons  of 
the  same  monastery.  It  is  however  com- 
monly confined  to  monks  of  the  mendicant 
orders.  Friars  are  generally  distinguished 
into  these  four  principal  branches : — 1. 
Franciscans,  Minors,  or  Grey  Friars ;  2. 
Augustines  ;  3.  Dominicans,  or  Black  Friars ; 
4.  Carmelites,  or  White  Friars.  From  these 
four  the  rest  of  the  orders  in  the  Roman 
Church  descend.  In  a  more  particular  sense 
the  term  Friar  is  applied  to  such  monks 
as  are  not  priests ;  for  those  in  orders  are  usu- 
ally dignified  with  the  appellation  of  Father. 

FRIDAY.  Friday  was,  both  in  the 
Greek  Church  and  Latin,  a  Litany  or  hu- 
miliation d  ay,  in  memory  of  Christ  crucified  : 
and  so  is  kept  in  ours.  It  is  our  M'eekly  fast 
for  our  share  in  the  death  of  Christ,  and  its 
gloom  is  only  dispersed  if  Christmas  day 
happens  to  fall  thereon  (See  Stations  ;  Week- 
days). 

FRONTAL.  The  antependium  or  vest- 
ment that  hangs  around  and  in  front  of  the 

FUNERAL  SERVICES  (See  Burial  of 
the  Dead,  and  Dead).  The  office  which  the 
Enghsh  Church  appoints  to  be  used  at  the 
burial  of  the  dead  is,  like  all  her  other  offices, 
of  most  ancient  date,  having  been  used  by 
the  Church  in  the  East  and  the  West  from 
the  remotest  antiquity,  and  having  been 
only  translated  into  English  by  the  bishops 
and  divines  who  reformed  our  Church.  But 
against  this  ofiice,  as  against  others,  objec- 
tions have  been  raised ;  chiefly  against  saying 
that  we  commit  our  brother's  "  body  to  the 
grotmd,  earth  to  earth,  ashes  to  ashes,  dust 
to  dust,  in   sure  and  certain  hope  of  the 


GELASIAN  SACEAMENTARY 

•yaiivva)  the  vale  of  Hinnom,  S.E.  of  Jeru- 
salem, in  wliioli  human  sacrifices  were  offered 
to  Molech,  after  the  introduction  of  fire-gods 
by  Ahaz.  The  Rabbis  say,  that  the  ido- 
laters were  wont  to  beat  a  drum,  lest  the 
people  should  hear  the  cries  of  the  chil- 
dren that  were  thrown  into  the  fire  when 
they  sacrificed  them  to  idols.  This  valley 
was,  in  consequence  of  these  abominations, 
polluted  by  Josiah  (2  Kings  xxiii.  10) ;  and 
iifterwards  was  the  place  for  casting  out  and 
liuming  all  offal,  and  the  corpses  of  criminals. 
The  awfulness  of  the  place,  and  the  ever- 
burning fires,  caused  it  to  be  used  in  later 
times  as  the  image  of  hell,  "  where  their 
worm  dieth  not  and  the  fire  is  not  quenched." 
The  ancient  writers  did  not  make  use  of  this 
word,  and  it  was  first  used  in  the  gospel. — 
Alford's  (?.  T.,  St.  Matt.  v.  22;  Diet,  of 
Bible.     [H.] 

GELASIAN  SACRAMENTAEY  (See 
Sacramentaries). 

GENERAL  CONFESSION.  So  called 
(^1)  because  it  is  for  use  on  general  occasions 
as  distinguished  from  particular  occasions. 
(2)  Because  it  is  for  all  persons.  The  gene- 
ral confession  in  the  morning  and  evening 
service  was  probably  composed,  or  rather 
compiled,  by  some  of  the  revisers  of  1552. 
The  other  general  confessions  in  our  Prayer 
Book  are  in  the  office  for  Holy  Communion, 
and  the  Commination  service.  These  are 
more  fervent,  as  would  be  expected  from  their 
jxisition,  but  not  so  complete.  —  Bishop 
Barry's  P.  B.  (See  Confession).     [H.] 

GENERAL  THANKSGIVING,  distin- 
guished from  thanksgivings  for  special  bene- 
fits. The  form  of  general  thanksgiving  in 
our  Prayer  Book  was  composed  by  Bishop 
Reynolds  and  inserted  in  1662.  The  custom 
of  repeating  this  thanksgiving  after  the  minis- 
ter is  common  in  America,  and  in  English 
churches  on  the  Continent ;  but  though 
this  may  seem  to  harmonize  with  the 
meaning  of  the  word  "  general,"  it  was  not 
so  intended,  and  is  not  authorised  by  the 
rubrics.     [H.] 

GENERATION,  THE  ETERNAL 
{See  Eternity).  It  is  thus  that  the  filiation 
without  beginning  of  the  Only  Begotten  of 
the  Father  is  expressed. 

The  distinction  of  a  threefold  generation 
of  the  Son  is  thus  explained: — 1.  The  first  and 
most  proper  filiation  and  generation  is  His 
eternally  existing  in  and  of  the  Father,  the 
eternal  Adyor  of  the  eternal  Mind.  In  respect 
of  this,  chiefly.  He  is  the  only  begotten,  and 
a  distinct  person  from  the  Father.  His 
other  generations  were  rather  condescensions, 
first  to  creatures  in  general,  next  to  men  in 
particular.  2.  His  second  generation  was 
His  condescension,  manifestation,  coming 
forth,  as  it  were,  from  the  Father  (though 
never  separated  or  divided  from  Him),   to 


GENERATION 


3G1 


create  the  world:  this  was  in  time,  and  a 
voluntary  thing  ;  and  in  this  respect, 
properly,  He  may  be  thought  to  be  first 
born  of  every  creature,  or  before  all  creatures. 
3.  His  third  generation,  or  filiation,  was 
when  He  condescended  to  be  born  of  a  pure 
virgin,  and  to  become  man  also  without 
ceasing  to  be  God. — Waterland. 

God  the  Father  from  all  eternity  com- 
municated to  His  Son  His  own  individual 
nature  and  substance;  so  that  the  same 
Godhead  which  is  in  the  Father  originally 
and  primarily,  is  also  in  the  Son  by  deriva- 
tion and  communication.  By  this  com- 
munication there  was  given  to  the  Son  all 
those  attributes  and  perfections  which  do 
simply  and  absolutely  belong  to  the  Divine 
nature;  there  was  a  communication  of  all 
the  proproties  which  naturally  belong  to 
the  essence  communicated  ;  and  hence  it  is 
that  the  Son  is  eternal,  omniscient,  omni- 
present, and  the  like,  in  the  same  infinite 
perfection  as  His  Father  is.  The  natural 
properties  were  thus  communicated ;  but 
we  cannot  say  the  same  of  the  personal  pro- 
perties, it  being  impossible  they  should  be 
communicated,  as  being  inseparable  from 
the  person :  such  are,  the  act  of  communicat- 
ing the  essence,  the  generation  itself,  aud 
the  personal  pre-eminence  of  the  Father, 
founded  on  that  generation.  These  were 
not  communicated,  but  are  proper  to  the 
Father ;  as,  on  the  other  hand,  the  personal 
properties  of  the  Son  (filiation  and  subordina- 
tion) are  proper  to  the  Son,  and  do  not  be- 
long to  the  Father.  And  although  in  this 
incomprehensible  mystery  we  use  the  term 
generation  (the  Scripture  having  given  us 
sufficient  authority  to  do  so,  by  styling  Him 
God's  Son,  His  proper  Son,  and  His  only  be- 
gotten Son),  yet,  by  this  term,  we  are  not 
to  understand  a  proceeding  from  non- 
existence to  existence,  which  is  the  physical 
notion  of  generation ;  nor  do  we  understand 
it  in  that  low  sense  in  which  it  is  agreeable 
to  creatures ;  hut  as  it  is  consistent  with  the 
essential  attributes  of  God,  of  which  neces- 
sary existence  is  one.  Nor,  further,  are  we 
in  this  generation  to  suppose  any  division  of 
the  essence,  or  auy  external  separation.  The 
communication  of  the  nature  was  not  a 
separate  one,  like  that  of  finite  beings,  but 
merely  internal:  and,  though  the  Son  be 
generated  from  the  substance  of  the  Father 
(and  thence  be  a  distinct  person  from  Him), 
yet  He  still  continues  to  be  in  the  Father, 
and  the  Father  m  Him ;  herein  differing 
from  the  production  of  all  created  beings, 
that  in  them  the  producer  and  the  produced 
become  two  distinct  individuals,  which  in 
this  generation  cannot  be  affirmed.  The 
term  used  by  the  Greek  Fathers  to  express 
this  internal  or  undivided  existence  in  the 
same  nature,   iiLTr(pi-)(a>pi]<m  ;  that  of  the 


362 


GENESIS 


Latin  Fathers,  circumincessio ;  and  that  dis- 
tinction of  the  schoolmen,  generatio  ah 
intra ;  are  terms  which  are  as  expressive  as 
any  words  can  be  of  a  mystery  so  far  above 
our  comprehension.  The  Father  and  the 
Son  by  this  communication  do  not  become 
two  Gods  (as  Adam  and  Seth  are  two  men), 
but  are  only  one  God  in  the  same  undivided 
essence.  The  communication  of  this  nature 
neither  did  nor  could  infringe  the  unity  of 
it,  because  the  Divine  essence  is  simply  one, 
and  therefore  cannot  be  divided;  is  ab- 
solutely infinite,  and  therefore  incapable  of 
being  multiplied  into  more  infinities.  And 
this,  by  the  way,  sufficiently  shows  the 
weakness  and  falseness  of  that  charge  which 
has  been  so  often  thrown  on  the  orthodox 
scheme  of  the  Trinity,  namely,  that  it  is 
downright  tritheism,  and  that  to  maintain 
that  the  three  persons  are  each  of  them  God, 
is  in  effect  to  maintain  three  Gods  ;  a  charge 
which  is  so  far  from  being  a  just  conse- 
quence of  our  principles,  that  it  is  manifestly 
inconsistent  with  them,  and  impossible  to 
be  true  upon  them.  We  hold  the  Divine 
essence  to  be  one  simple,  indivisible  essence ; 
we  assert  that  the  Father  communicated  to 
the  Son,without  division,  this  His  individual 
substance ;  and  therefore,  upon  these  our 
principles,  the  unity  of  the  Divine  essence 
must  still  unavoidably  be  preserved;  and  upon 
this  scheme  the  three  distinct  persons  neither 
are,  nor  can  be  (what  is  falsely  suggested 
against  us)  three  distinct  Gods.  This  com- 
munication of  the  Divine  substance  to  God 
the  Son  was  not  a  temporary  one,  but  strictly 
and  absolutely  eternal ;  eternal  in  the  proper 
sense  of  that  word ;  in  the  same  sense  in 
which  eternity  is  ascribed  to  the  Divine 
nature  itself ;  and  eternal  in  the  same  sense 
as  God  the  Father  Himself  is  so. 

GENESIS.  The  first  book  of  the  Bible. 
The  Hebrews  call  it  rvmra  (from  Kn3, 
to  mould  by  cutting,  then  1;o  create;  see 
Davidson  on  Bib.  Crit.  app.  p.  399,  seq.) ; 
this  being  the  first  word  of  the  book.  The 
Greeks  gave  it  the  name  of  Oenesis,  or  Gene- 
ration, because  it  contains  the  genealogy  of 
the  first  patriarchs  from  Adam  to  the  sons  and 
grandsons  of  Jacob;  or  because  it  begins 
with  the  history  of  the  creation  of  the  world. 
It  includes  the  history  0^^2369  years,  from 
the  beginning  of  the  world  to  the  death  of 
the  patriarch  Joseph.     [H.] 

GENTILE  (From  Gentes).  All  the 
people  in  the  world,  except  the  Jews,  were 
called  Gentiles. 

GENTLEMEN  OP  THE  CHAPEL 
ROYAL.  The  lay  singers  of  the  Royal 
Chapel  are  so  called  ;  and  their  duty  is  to 
perform  witli  the  priests,  in  order,  the 
choral  service  there,  which  was  formerly 
daily.  According  to  the  present  rule,  they 
attend  in  monthly  courses  of  eight  at  a  time. 


GENUFLEXION 

In  ancient  times  this  body  was  more  numer- 
ous :  Edward  VI.'s  chapel  had  thirty-two 
gentlemen ;  Queen  Elizabeth's  thirty;  James 
I.'s  twenty-three. 

GENUFLECTENTES  (yowKXlvovr^s : 
prostrati).  An  order  of  penitents  in  the 
primitive  Church.  They  ranked  above  the 
audientes  and  below  the  cousistentes.  A 
form  of  prayer  for  the  penitents  is  preserved 
in  the  Apostolic  Constitutions  (viii.  9, 10). 
Thej'  were  allowed  to  stay  in  the  church 
kneeling  while  prayers  were  offered  for 
them,  and  their  names  read  out,  so  that 
each  might  be  remembered  by  the  faithful. 
They  then  received  benediction  and  were 
dismissed  before  the  celebration. — St.  Chrys. 
Horn,  xviii.  in  2  Gor.  ;  Horn.  Ixxii.  in  Matt.  ; 
Bingham,  x.  c.  2 :  xviii.  c.  i. 

GENUFLEXION.  Literally,  bending  the 
knee.  Kneeling,  or  even  prostration,  was 
the  posture  of  the  early  Christians  in  prayer. 
"Let  us  fall  down  before  the  Lord,"  says 
Clemens  Romanus  {Ep.  i.  ad  Cor.  c.  48) ; 
and  many  early  writers,  too  numerous  to 
mention,  refer  to  this  attitude  in  prayer. 
St.  Augustine  distinguishes  between  kneel- 
ing and  prostration  ;  "  they  who  pray,"  he 
says,  "  do  with  the  members  of  their  body 
that  which  befits  suppliants,  when  they  fix 
their  knees,  stretch  both  their  hands,  el- 
even prostrate  themselves  upon  the  ground  " 
{De  Oura  pro  Mortuis,  c.  v.).  And  St. 
Chrysostom  speaks  of  lying  on  the  floor — 
eV  lha<^ovs  Kfi'/xf^a— when  the  most  solemn 
part  of  the  service,  those  who  could  not 
partake  of  the  Holy  Table  being  shut  out, 
was  solemnized.  But  this  may  refer  to 
kneeling,  and  there  is  no  doubt  kneeling 
was  the  ordinary  attitude  of  prayer; 
"  Keifievos  inl  Toir  yovacn "  is  the  phrase 
used  by  Eusebius,  from  whom  also  we  learn 
that  St.  James's  knees,  from  continual 
kneeling,  became  hard  as  those  of  a  camel 
(Euseb.  S.  E.  ii.  c.  xxiii.  and  also  v.  c.  5). 
But  the  ancients  allowed  of  no  light  or 
extravagant  gestures.  They  required  a  grave 
deportment  in  those  who  were  met  together 
to  worship  God.  Tertullian  speaks  of 
modesty  and  humility  even  in  lifting  up 
the  hands  in  prayer  (Tertul.  de  Orat.  c.  13)  ; 
and  St.  Chrysostom  strongly  inveighs  against 
"  mimic  or  theatrical  gestures  "  (Horn.  i. 
de  verb.  Esai.  tom.  3 ;  also  19  in  St.  Matt.). 
The  media3val  custom  of  just  touching  the 
ground  with  one  knee,  at  certain  times, 
which  goes  by  the  name  "  genuflexion," 
would  seem  to  have  no  primitive  authority. 
— Bict.  Christ.  Ant. ;  Bingham,  xiii.  8.  [H.] 

GEOMETRICAL.  The  style  of  Gothic 
architecture  which  succeeded  the  Early 
English  about  1245,  and  gave  place  to  the 
Flowing  Decorated  about  1315.  In  this 
style  window  tracery  was  first  introduced, 
and  it  is  distinguished  from  the  tracery  of 


GESTUEES 

the  succeeding  style  by  the  use  of  simple 
geometrical  forms,  each  in  general  perfect  on 
itself,  and  not  running  into  one  another  (See 
Tracery).  (See  my  note  on  them  :  they  are 
useless).  From  the  use  of  tracery  large 
windows  naturally  followed,  sometimes  even 
extending  to  eight  or  nine  lights ;  and  from 
these  larger  openings  in  the  walls  some  con- 
stractive  changes  followed,  especially  in  the 
greater  weight  and  projection  of  the  but- 
iresses.  The  doors  are  often,  as  in  the 
Early  Enghsh,  divided  by  a  central  shaft. 
The  piers  very  soon  lose  the  detached 
shafts,  and  are  rather  formed  of  solid  clusters. 
In  early  Decorated  the  triforium  is  still  re- 
tained as  a  distinct  feature;  in  later,  it  is 
treated  as  a  decorative  band  of  panelling. 
Vaulting  hardly  advances  upon  the  simple 
forms  of  the  preceding  style.  AH  decorative 
features  are  of  the  very  highest  order  of 
excellence,  and  are  far  more  natural  than 
either  before  or  after,  without  losing  in 
grace,  or  force,  or  character.  There  is  no 
single  decoration  peculiar  to  this  style,  ex- 
cept perhaps  the  ball-flower.  And  crockets 
first  appear  in  it;  on  the  other  hand,  the 
dog-tooth  is  quite  given  up.  Sir  Gilbert 
Scott  pointed  out  that  this,  which  he  con- 
sidered the  only  complete  style,  was  the 
only  one  common  to  England  and  the  Conti- 
nent. From  it  they  decUned  in  different 
directions  here  and  abroad.     [G.] 

GESTURES.  Motions  of  the  body  or 
limbs  expressive  of  sentiment.  There  has 
always  been,  especially  in  times  of  revival, 
a  tendency  to  exaggeration  in  this  respect. 
Thus  St.  Chrysostom  speaks  of  "  waving  of 
hands,  beating  of  feet,  and  agitation  of  the 
body,"  as  being  in  some  places  introduced 
into  the  services  (Horn.  i.  de  verb.  Esai."). 
Against  such  extravagances  many  of  the 
early  Fathers  inveighed.  Tertullian,  for 
instance,  requires  a  "  modesty  and  humility, 
even  in  lifting  up  the  hands  in  prayer,  that 
they  should  not  be  tossed  up  indecently  on 
high ; "  "  ne  vultu  quidem  in  audaciam 
erecto,"  &c.  (de  Orat.  c.  13).  St.  Cyprian, 
too,  urges  quietness  and  modesty  in  the 
public  worship  (de  Orat.  Bom.  p.  140,  old 
ed.) ;  and  St.  Chrysostom,  as  quoted  above, 
speaks  strongly  about  the  extravagant  ges- 
tures that  some  brought  into  the  church,  as 
if  they  were  mimics  and  dancers.  But 
expressive  gestures  were  always  observed 
in  the  ancient  times.  Thus  Tertullian  says, 
"  nos  vero  (manus)  non  attoUimus  tantum, 
sed  etiam  expandimus,  et  Dominica  passione 
modulantes,  et  orantes  Christo  confitemur  " 
(De  Orat.  c.  11).  The  arms  were  extended 
so  as  to  be  like  to  the  cross,  and  St.  Ambrose 
is  described  as  praying  "  expansis  manibus 
in  modum  crucis"  (Paulin.  Vit.  Anibros. 
p.  12).  "  As  the  ancients  were  in  no  way 
averse  to  any  rites  and  ceremonies,  habits 


GIEDLE 


3G3.- 


or  gestures,  that  were  decent  and  signifi- 
cant in  their  own  nature,  and  had  any  real, 
tendency  towards  piety ;  so  they  were  utter 
enemies  to  such  as  were  insignificant  and 
trivial,  light  and  theatrical,  and  discounte- 
nanced them  as  the  effects  of  superstition 
or  vanity,  arising  from  misapprehension  of 
religion  which  they  labom-ed  to  extirpate, 
but  could  not  always  conquer ;  men's  cor- 
rupt inclinations  disposing  them  to  commute 
the  great  things  of  religion  for  those  that 
were  small  in  comparison,  and  sometimes 
for  those  which  were  a  real  detriment  and 
disadvantage  to  it-"  (Bingham,  bk.  xiii. 
c.  8).  The  Church  of  England  has  no  rules 
with  regard  to  "gestures,"  except  about 
kneeling  and  standing,  at  difierent  parts  of 
the  service.  A  rubric  in  King  Edward  VI.'s- 
first  book  says, "  as  touching  kneeling,  cross- 
ing, holding  up  of  hands,  knocking  upon  the 
breast,  and  other  gestures,  they  may  be  used 
or  left,  as  every  man's  devotion  serveth  with- 
out shame."  "  Kneeling  in  prayer,"  says  Dr. 
Dykes,  "standing  to  sing  praise,  turning 
towards  the  east  when  saying  the  creeds, 
humbly  bowing  the  head  at  the  name  of 
Jesus  or  of  the  Blessed  Trinity  : — these  are 
all  significant  gestures  of  reverence  towards 
One  who  is  really  and  truly  present  to- 
accept  the  worship  which  they  ofler ;  One 
Who  accepts  such  reverence  from  the  holy 
angels  and  the  glorified  saints,  and  Who  will 
not  be  otherwise  than  willing  to  receive 
it  from  His  ministers  and  members  in  the 
Church  on  earth."— Blunt's  P.  B.  1. 1.  [H.] 

GHOST  (Sax.  gast ;  Ger.  geist).  (1)  A 
spirit :  the  soul  of  man.  It  is  rarely  used 
in  this  sense,  but  to  this  may  be  referred 
the  phrase  "  giving  up  the  ghost."  (2)  The 
soul  of  a  deceased  person  separate  from  the 
body:  an  apparition.  St.  Athanasius  says 
"visions  and  shades  of  the  saints,  which 
appear  at  the  temples  and  in  the  tombs,  are 
not  the  souls  of  the  saints  themselves,  but 
the  good  angels  appearing  in  their  shapes  "' 
(oi  iv  Tois  vaois :  Athanasius,  tom  ii.  p.  34)., 
(3)  The  third  Person  in  the  ever  blessed- 
Trinity  is  spoken  of  as  the  Holy  Ghost 
(See  Holy  Ghost).     [H.] 

GILD.  A  corporation  (See  Guild,  Fra- 
ternities). 

.  GIRDLE  (Cingulum;  the  Eastern 
Poyass).  A  cincture  binding  the  alb  round 
the  waist.  Formerly  it  was  flat  and  broad,, 
and  sometimes  adorned  with  jewels ;  in  the- 
Roman  Church  it  has  been  changed  into  a 
long  cord  mth  dependent  extremities  and 
tassels.  The  zone  is  fancifully  regarded 
by  some  ritualists  as  a  type  of  purity : 
also  it  is  supposed  to  signify  the  close- 
mind  which  the  minister  ought  to  have  at 
prayers  when  he  celebrates.  According  to- 
the  "  Rationale  "  it  signifies  the  scourge  with 
which  Christ  was  scourged  (See  Vestments)^ 


364: 


GLEBE 


GLEBE.  Every  churoli  is  of  common 
right  entitled  to  house  and  glebe. 

These  are  both  comprehended  under  the 
name  of  manse,  and  the  rule  of  the  canon 
iaw  is,  "  Sancitum  est,  ut  uniouique  ecclesiaB 
unus  mansus  integer,  absque  ullo  servitio, 
tribuatur."  This  is  repeated  in  the  canons 
of  Egbert ;  and  the  assigning  of  these  was 
of  such  absolute  necessity,  that  without 
tnem  no  church  could  be  regularly  conse- 
crated. The  fee  simple  of  the  glebe  is  in 
obeyance,  from  the  French  hayer,  to  expect, 
i.e.  it  is  only  in  the  remembrance,  expecta- 
tion, and  intendment  of  law. 

After  induction,  the  freehold  of  the 
glebe  is  in  the  parson,  but  with  these 
limitations :  (1)  That  he  may  not  alienate, 
nor  exchange,  except  upon  the  conditions 
set  forth  in  the  statutes  cited  below ;  (2) 
that  he  may  not  commit  waste  by  selling 
wood,  &c.  But  it  has  been  adjudged  that 
tbe  digging  of  mines  in  glebe  lands  is  not 
waste  ;  for  the  court  said,  in  denying  a  pro- 
hibition, "  if  this  were  accounted  waste,  no 
mines  that  are  in  glebe  lands  could  ever 
be  opened." 

Glebe  lands  in  the  hands  of  the  parson 
do  not  pay  tithe  to  the  vicar,  though  en- 
dowed generally  of  the  tithes  of  all  lands 
within  the  parish ;  nor  being  in  the  hands 
of  the  vicar,  do  they  pay  tithe  to  the 
parson.  This  is  according  to  the  known 
maxim  of  the  canon  law,  that  "  The  Church 
shall  not  pay  tithes  to  the  Church  ; "  but 
otherwise  if  the  glebe  be  leased  out,  for 
then  it  is  liable  to  pay  tithes  respectively 
as  other  lands  are.  By  a  statute  of  Henry 
VIIL,  if  the  parson  dies  in  possession 
of  glebe,  and  another  is  inducted  before 
severance  of  the  crop  from  the  ground, 
his  executor  shall  have  the  corn,  but  the 
successor  shall  have  the  tithes :  the  reason 
is,  that,  although  the  executor  represents 
the  testator,  yet  he  cannot  represent  him 
as  parsooi ;  inasmuch  as  another  parson  is 
inducted.  By  13  Eliz.  c.  10,  the  term 
for  leasing  glebe  is  limited  to  twenty-one 
years,  or  three  lives.  The  55  Geo.  IIL 
c.  147,  56  Geo.  III.  c.  52,  1  Geo.  IV.  c.  6, 
are  Acts  for  "  enabling  spiritual  persons  to 
exchange  their  parsonage  houses  or  glebe 
lands  "  (See  also  6  Geo.  IV.  c.  8  ;  7  Geo. 
IV.  c.  66 ;  1  &  2  Vict.  c.  23 ;  2  &  3  Vict, 
c.  49 ;  5  &  6  Vict.  c.  27  ;  1  &  2  Vict.  c. 
106,  s.  93). 

Canon  87.  A  Terrier  of  Olebe  lands,  and 
other  Possessions  belonging  to  Churches. — 
■"We  ordain  that  the  archbishops  and  all 
bishops  within  their  several  dioceses  shall 
procure  (as  much  as  in  them  lieth)  that  a 
true  note  and  terrier  of  all  the  glebes, 
lands,  meadows,  gardens,  orchards,  houses, 
stocks,  implements,  tenements,  and  por- 
tions of  tithes,  lying  out  of  their  parishes 


GLORIA  PATRI 

(which  belong  to  any  parsonage,  or  vicar-      i 
age,  or  rural  prebend),  be  taken  by  the  view      ! 
of  honest  men  in  every  parish,  by  the  ap-      j 
pointment    of    the    bishop    (whereof   the 
minister  to  be  one),  and  be  laid  up  in  the 
bishop's  registry,  there  to  be  for  a  perpe- 
tual memory  thereof." 

By  1  &  2  Vict.  c.  106,  the  bishop  may 
assign  four  acres  of  glebe  to  the  curate, 
occupying  the  house  of  a  non-resident  in- 
cumbent, at  a  fixed  rent,  to  be  approved  of 
by  the  bishop. 

GLORIA  IN  EXCELSIS.  "Glory  be 
to  God  on  high."  One  of  the  doxologies 
of  the  Church,  sometimes  called  the  angelic 
hymn,  because  the  first  part  of  it  was  sung 
by  the  angels  at  the  birth  of  ovu:  Lord.  This 
first  part  is  found  in  the  Liturgies  of  St. 
James,  and  that  of  St.  Chiysostom.  The 
latter  portion  of  this  celebrated  hymn  is 
ascribed  to  Telesphorus,  bishop  of  Rome, 
about  the  year  of  Christ  137 ;  though  there  is 
no  evidence  that  he  did  more  than  order  its 
use  in  the  Liturgy,  if  even  that.  The  whole 
hymn,  with  veiy  little  difference,  is  to  be 
found  in  the  Apostolical  Constitutions 
(vii.  47);  it  also  exists  in  MS.  in  the 
Alexandrine  Codex,  is  quoted  by  Athanasius 
in  his  treatise  on  Virginity  (torn.  ii.  p.  122. 
Bened.,  but  this  Ls  said  to  be  spurious), 
and  was  estabhshed  to  be  used  in  the  Church 
service  by  tbe  fourth  Council  of  Toledo, 
A.D.  633.  It  is  used  by  both  the  Greek  and 
Latin  Church,  but  in  the  former,  except 
among  the  Nestorians,  as  a  part  of  a  morn- 
ing canticle,  not  in  the  Holy  Eucharist.  In 
an  early  English  Psalter  going  by  the  name 
of  Athelstan  it  is  called  a  Sunday  morning 
hymn.  "  In  the  Eastern  Church,"  says 
Palmer,  "this  hymn  is  more  than  1500 
years  old,  and  the  Church  of  England  has 
used  it,  either  at  the  beginning  or  end  of 
the  Liturgy,  for  above  1200  years."  It  is 
now  used  at  the  conclusion  of  the  Com- 
munion Service ;  but  in  the  First  Book  of 
King  Edward  VI.  was  placed  near  the 
beginning  (See  Hymn). — Palmer,  Orig. 
Liturg.  ii.  158,  &c. ;  Blunt,  Diet.  Doct.  Theol. 
291 ;  Annot.  P.  B.  194.  See  article  by  Dr. 
Swainson  in  Diet.  Christ.  Antiq.     [H.] 

GLORIA  PATRI.  "Glory  be  to  the 
Father."  The  Latin  title  of  one  of  the 
primitive  doxologies  of  the  Church,  some- 
times called  the  lesser  doxology,  to  distin- 
guish it  from  the  Gloria  in  excelsis,  or 
angelic  hymn.  Prom  the  times  of  the 
apostles  it  has  been  customary  to  mingle 
ascriptions  of  glory  with  prayer,  and  to  con- 
clude the  praises  of  the  Church,  and  also 
sermons,  with  glory  to  the  Father,  to  the 
Son,  and  to  the  Holy  Ghost.  The  first 
part  of  the  Gloria  Patri  is  traced  by  St. 
Basil  to  the  apostolic  age  (£'p.  Ixiii.).  He 
behoves  it  to  be  one  of  the  "  traditions " 


GLOSS 

which  St.  Paul  praises  the  Corinthians  for 
keeping,  and  exhorts  the  Thessalonians  to 
hold  (1  Cor.  xi.  2;  2  Thess.  ii.  15).  In 
the  writings  of  the  Fathers,  doxolo^ies  are 
of  very  frequent  occurrence,  and  in  the  early 
Church  they  appear  to  have  been  used  as 
tests,  by  which  orthodox  Christians  and 
Churches  were  distinguished  from  those 
which  were  infected  with  heresy.  The 
doxologies  then  in  use,  though  the  same  in 
substance,  were  various  in  form  and  mode  of 
expression.  The  Arians  soon  took  advan- 
tage of  this  diversit}"-,  and  wrested  some  of 
them  so  as  to  appear  to  favour  their  own 
views.  One  of  the  doxologies  which  ran  in 
these  words, "  Glory  be  to  the  Father,  hy  the 
Son,  in  the  Holy  Ghost,"  was  employed  by 
them  in  support  of  their  heretical  opinions. 
In  consequence  of  this,  and  to  set  the  true 
doctrine  of  the  Church  in  the  clearest  light, 
the  form,  as  now  used,  was  adopted  as  tlie 
standing  doxology  of  the  Church  (See 
BoxoTogy). 

It  was  a  hymn  of  most  general  use,  and  a 
doxology  offered  to  God  in  the  close  of  every 
solemn  office.  The  Western  Church  re- 
peated it  at  the  end  of  every  psalm,  and  the 
Eastern  Church  at  the  end  of  the  last  psalm. 
— The  whole  commonly  running  thus :  "  To 
Father,  Son,  and  Holy  Ghost,  be  all  glory, 
worship,  thanksgiving,  honour,  and  ador- 
ation, now  and  for  ever,  throughout  all  ages, 
world  without  end.  Amen."- — Bingham,  bk. 
xiv.  0.  1;  Bouth,  i?e%.  Sac.  iii.  299. 
Reverence  was  enjoined  at  these  words,  not 
only  in  the  choirs  of  abbeys  and  convents, 
but  by  provincial  canons.  "  Quoties  dicitur 
G.  P.  . . .  ad  eadem  verba  Deo  humiliter  se 
inclinent." — ^Wilkins,  Condi,  tom.  iii.  p.  30  ; 
Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  Eccl.  Ang.  iii.  3,  4,  94 
(See  Bowing').     [H.] 

GLOSS.    A  comment. 

GNOSTICS  {yvaa-is,  hnowledge).  I.  The 
word  Chuostic  properly  signifies  a  learned 
or  enlightened  person;  and  thus  Clement 
of  Alexandria  uses  it  throughout  his  Stro- 
mata  (i.  6,  &c.)  to  denote  the  perfect 
Christian,  who  is  the  true  Gnostic.  But 
in  its  more  common  use,  the  term  signifies 
a  class  of  heretics,  who,  in  the  earliest 
times,  pretended  to  superior  knowledge, 
and  mixed  up  some  Christian  ideas  and 
terms  with  systems  based  on  Platonism, 
Oriental  philosophy,  or  corrupt  Judaism. 
Thus  the  teim  is  used  by  Irenasus  in  the 
2nd  century,  and  Hippolytus  early  in  the 
3rd  century  (Iren.  adv.  Emr.  iii.  4 ;  Hippol. 
PhUos.  v.).  To  this  class  most  of  the 
earliest  sects  belonged.  Simon  Magus  may 
be  considered  as  the  foserunner  of  G  nosticism, 
but  it  seems  more  in  accordance  with 
historical  evidence  to  consider  it  as  the 
natural  outcome  of  the  combined  Jewish  and 
Gentile  intellect  when  reasoning    on    the 


GNOSTICS 


.^6.5 


philosojihy  of  Cliristianity,  and  of  other 
religions.  In  the  second  century  there  were 
many  varieties  of  Gnostics — as  the  followers 
of  Basilides  Saturniuus,  Carpocrates,  Valen- 
tinus.  Sec.  Of  these  the  Carpooratians  alone 
are  said  to  have  assumed  the  name. 

II.  The  Gnostic  systems  held  in  common 
a  belief  in  one  supreme  God,  dwelling  from 
eternity  in  the  Pleroma,  or  fulness  of  light. 
From  Him  proceed  successive  generations  of 
spiritual  beings — called  by  Yalentinus  jEons. 
In  proportion  as  these  emanations  are  more 
remote  from  the  primal  source,  the  likeness 
of  His  perfections  in  them  is  continually 
fainter.  Matter  is  regarded  as  eternal,  and 
as  inherently  evil.  Out  of  it  the  world  was 
formed,  not  by  the  Supreme  God,  but  by 
the  Demiurge — a  being  who  is  represented 
by  some  heresiarchs  as  merely  a  subordi- 
nate and  unconscious  instrument  of  the 
Divine  will,  and  by  others  as  positively 
malignant,  and  hostile  to  the  Supreme. 
The  Demiurge,  it  was  said,  was  the  national 
God  of  the  Jews — the  God  of  the  Old 
Testament;  according,  therefore,  as  he  is 
viewed,  the  Mosaic  economy  is  either 
recognised  as  preparatory,  or  is  rejected  as 
evil.  The  mission  of  Christ  was  for  the 
purpose  of  delivering  man  from  the  tyranny 
of  the  Demiurge.  But  the  Christ  of 
Gnosticism  was  neither  very  God  nor  very 
man.  His  spiritual  natuie,  being  an 
emanation  from  the  Supreme  God,  was 
necessarily  inferior  to  its  original ;  and,  on 
the  other  hand,  an  emanation  from  God 
could  not  dwell  in  a  material,  and  con- 
sequently evil,  body.  Either,  therefore, 
Jesus  was  a  mere  man,  on  whom  the  Mon 
Christ  descended  at  his  baptism,  to  forsake 
Him  again  before  His  crucifixion ;  or  the 
body  with  which  Christ  seemed  to  be 
clothed  was  only  a  phantom,  and  all  His 
actions  were  only  in  appearance  (See 
Docetie). 

The  same  view  as  to  the  evil  nature  of 
matter  led  the  Gnostics  to  deny  the  resur- 
rection of  the  body.  They  could  admit  no 
other  than  a  spiritual  resurrection :  the 
object  of  their  philosophy  was  to  emanci- 
pate the  soul  ft-om  its  gross  and  material 
prison  at  death;  the  soul  of  the  perfect 
Gnostic,  having  already  risen  in  baptism, 
was  to  be  gathered  into  the  bosom  of  God, 
while  such  souls  as  j'ct  lacked  their  full 
perfection,  were  to  work  it  out  in  a  series 
of  transmigrations. 

Since  matter  was  evil,  the  Gnostic  was 
required  to  overcome  it.  But  here  arose 
an  important  practical  difference ;  for, 
while  some  sought  the  victory  by  a  high, 
ascetic  abstraction  from  the  things  of  sense, 
the  baser  kind  professed  to  show  their 
superiority  and  indifference  by  wallowing 
in  impurity  and  excess.     The  Gnostics  are 


.366 


GOD 


little  heard  of  after  the  2nd  century ;  but 
their  principles  survived  among  the  Ma- 
niohajans.  For  a  very  full  account  of 
Gnosticism  see  Diet.  Eccl.  Biog.  (See  Bar- 
desanists,  Basilidians,  Carpocratians,  Mar- 
cionites,  Ophitai,  Valentinians). 

GOD.  The  name  we  give  to  that  eternal, 
infinite,  and  incomprehensible  Being,  the 
Iilaker  and  Preserver  of  all  things,  who 
exists  One  Being  in  a  Trinity  of  persons. 
Tlie  word  is  found  with  only  slight  varia- 
tions in  Anglo-Saxon,  Danish,  Dutch,  Ice- 
landic, Gothic,  and  German:  all  from  a 
Teutonic  base,  Gutha,  of  unknown  origin. 

Article  I.  "  There  is  but  one  living  and 
true  God,  everlasting,  -(vithout  body,  parts, 
•or  passions ;  of  infinite  power,  wisdom,  and 
goodness;  the  Maker  and  Preserver  of  all 
things,  both  visible  and  invisible.  And  in 
unity  of  this  Godhead  there  be  three  per- 
sons, of  one  substance,  jMwer,  and  eternity ; 
the  Father,  the  Son,  and  the  Holy  Ghost." 
Athanasian  Creed — "The  Father  is  God: 
the  Son  is  God:  and  the  Holy  Ghost  is 
God." 

The  Father  is  God. 

God  the  Father  (St.  John  vi.  27 ;  Gal.  i.  1, 
3;  1  Thess.  i.  1).  God,  even  the  Father 
(1  Cor.  XV.  24 ;  2  Cor.  i.  3 ;  St.  James  iii.  9). 
-One  God  and  Father  (Eph.  iv.  C).  One 
God  the  Father  (1  Cor.  viii.  6) ;  and  the 
jiassages  where  God  is  spoken  of  as  the 
Father  of  oin:  Lord  Christ,  the  Son  of  the 
living  God  (St.  Matt.  xvi.  16  ;  St.  John  iii. 
16 ;  vi.  27 ;  Rom.  v.  10  ;  viii.  3  ;  xv.  C). 

The  Son  is  God. 

I.  So  expressly  declared. 

The  mighty  God  (Isa.  ix.  6).  Make 
straight — a  highway  for  our  God  (xl.  3). 
Thy  throne,  0  God,  is  for  ever  and  ever! 
,{Ps.  xlv.  6,  with  Heb.  i.  8).  I  will  save 
them  by  the  Lord  their  God  (Hosea  i.  7). 
Immanuel,  God  with  us  (Isa.  vii.  14;  St.  Matt, 
i.  23).  The  Word  was  God  (St.  John  i.  1) 
My  Lord  and  my  God  (xx.  28;  see  Ps. 
xxxv.  23).  Feed  the  Church  of  God 
which  he  has  purchased  with  his  own  blood 
<'Aots  XX.  28).  They  stoned  Stephen,  call- 
log  upon  God,  and  saying.  Lord  Jesus,  &c. 
(vii.  59).  Christ  is  over  all,  God  blessed 
for  ever  (Rom.  ix.  5).  God  was  manifest 
in  the  flesh,  &o.,  believed  on  in  the  world, 
received  up  into  g^orj''  (1  Tim.  iii.  16). 
God  our  Saviour  (Titus  ii.  10).  The 
great  God  (13).  Our  God  and  Saviour, 
Jesus  Christ  (Gr.)  (2  St.  Pet.  i.  1,  with  Titus 
li.  13).  Hereby  perceive  we  the  love  of 
God,  because  he  laid  down  his  life  for  us  (1 
St.  John  iii.  16).  The  true  God,  and  eternal 
life  (v.  20). 

II.  By  necessary  implication. 

The  angel  Jehovah  is  God  (Gen.  xxxi. 
11,  with  13 ;  and  xxxv.  9-13,  and  15  ;  xvi. 
9,  with  13 ;  Ex.  iii.  2,  with  4,  and  6).     I 


GOD 

am  Alpha  and  Omega — he  that  overcometh 
—I  will  be  his  God  (Rev.  xxi.  6,  7).  We 
must  all  stand  before  the  judgment  seat  of 
Christ,  for, — every  tongue  shall  confess  to 
God  (Rom.  xiv.  10,  11).  I  saw  the  dead, 
small  and  great,  stand  before  God,  &c. 
(Rev.  XX.  12).  Many  shall  he  (John  the 
Baptist)  turn  to  the  Lord  their  God,  for  he 
shall  go  before  him  (St.  Luke  i.  16, 17  ;  with 
St.  Matt.  iii.  11,  and  xi.  10).  The  Lord  God  of 
the  holy  prophets  sent  his  angel  (Bev.  xxii. 
6,  with  16).  I  Jesus  have  sent  mine  angel 
to  testify,  &c.  They  tempted  the  most 
high  God  (Ps.  Ixxviii.  56),  applied  to  Christ 
(1  Cor.  X.  9).  Behold  the  Lord  God  wiU 
come — behold  his  reward  is  with  him  (Isa. 
xl.  10,  with  Bev.  xxii.  12,  20).  Behold,  I 
come  quickly,  and  my  reward  is  with  me — 
I  am  Alpha  and  Omsc,a.  Surely  I  come 
quickly.  Amen.  Even  so,  come.  Lord  Jesus. 
— To  the  only  wise  God  our  Saviour,  be 
glory,  &c.     Amen.    (St.  Jude  25.) 

ni.  From  his  attributes. 

As  He  is  wisdom  itself  (Prov.  viii.  through- 
out ;  St.  Luke  xi.  49,  with  Col.  ii.  3). — As 
He  is  the  holy  one  (Ps.  xvi.  10) ;  the  most 
holy  (Dan.  ix.  24,  with  Rev.  in.  7). — As  He 
is  the  truth  (St.  John  xiv.  6,  and  Rev.  iii.  7, 
with  1  St.  John  v.  20). — As  He  is  eternal. — 
Eternal  life  (1  St.  John  i.  1,  2,  and  v.  20). 
— From  his  unchangeahleness  (Heb.  i.  11, 
12,  and  xiu.  8,  with  Mai.  iiL  6). — His  omni- 
presence (St.  John  iii.  13;  St.  Matt,  xviii. 
20 ;  xxviii.  20 ;  Eph.  i.  23  ;  iv.  10).— His 
omniscience  (Rev.  ii.  23;  St.  John  ii.  24, 
25;  v.  42).  Knowing  the  thoughts  (St. 
Matt.  is.  4;  xii.  15,  25;  St.  Mark  ii.  8; 
St.  Luke  V.  22 ;  vi.  8 ;  ix.  47 ;  xi.  17 ;  St. 
John  vi.  61,  64 ;  xvi.  19 ;  xxi.  17,  with  1 
Cor.  iv.  5 ;  this  with  1  Kings  viii.  39).  Thou, 
even  thou  only  (0  Lord  God),  knowest  the 
hearts  of  all  the  children  of  men. — Omnipo- 
tence :  The  works  of  creation.  All  things 
were  made  by  Him ;  and  without  Him  was 
not  anything  made  that  was  made  (St.  John 
i.  3,  with  Ps.  cii.  25;  Col.  i.  16,  and  Jer. 
X.  10,  11). — And  providence.  By  him  all 
things  consist  (Col.  i.  17).  Upholding  all 
things  by  the  word  of  His  power  (Heb.  i.  3) 
■ — Judging  the  world.  The  Lord  Jesus 
Christ,  who  shall  judge  the  quick  and  the 
dead  (2  Tim.  iv.  1,  &c.,  with  Gen.  xviii.  25, 
andPs.  1. 6).  God  is  judge  Himself. — Raising 
the  dead  (St.  John  vi.  40,  54 ;  v.  28,  29 ; 
with'Deut.  xxxi:.  39).  I,  even  I,  am  He, 
and  there  is  no  God  with  me ;  I  kill,  and  I 
make  alive. — The  forgiveness  of  sins  (St. 
Mark  ii.  10,  11,  &c.,  with  Isa.  sliii.  25).  I, 
even  I,  am  He  that  blotteth  out  thy  trans- 
gressions, and  St.  Mark  ii.  7. 

IV.  As  Divine  worship  is  due,  and  paid 
to  Him. 

Being  directed  by  prophecy.     All  kings 
shall  fall  down  before  Him  (Ps.  Ixxii.  11). 


GOD 

All  dominions  shall  serve  and  obey  Him 
(Dan.  vii.  27).  Kiss  the  Son,  lest  He  lie 
angry,  and  ye  perish  from  the  way  (Ps.  ii. 
12).  He  is  thy  Lord,  and  worship  thou 
Him  (xlv.  11).  Let  all  the  angels  of  God 
worship  Him !  (Heb.  i.  6).  All  men  should 
honour  the  Son,  even  as  they  honour  the 
Father.  External  worship  was  paid  by  the 
wise  men  (St.  Matt.  ii.  11)— by  the  leper 
(viii.  2)— by  the  ruler  (ix.  18)— by  the  dis- 
ciples in  the  storm  —  (xiv.  33) — bj'  the 
woman  of  Canaan  (xv.  25) — by  the  blind 
man  (St.  John  ix.  38) — by  the  Marys,  &c. 
(St.  Matt,  xxviii.  9),  and  by  His  disciples 
(Rev.  i.  17).  At  the  name  of  Jesus  every 
knee  should  bow  in  heaven  and  in  earth 
(Phil.  ii.  10;  compare  this  with  St.  Matt, 
iv.  10,  Thou  shalt  worship  the  Lord  thy 
God,  and  Him  only  shalt  thou  serve;  and 
Neh.  ix.  6,  Thou,  even  thou,  art  Lord  alone ; 
Thou  hast  made  heaven,  &c.,  and  the  host 
of  heaven  worshippeth  Thee !). 

V.  As  there  must  be  faith,  and  hope,  and 
trust  in  him. 

See  St.  John  iii.  15,  16 ;  xiv.  1 ;  xii.  44 ; 
Kom.  X.  11 ;  xv.  12 ;  Acts  xvi.  31 ;  Eph. 
i.  12, 13,  with  Jer.  xvii.  5.  Cursed  be  the 
man  that  trnsteth  in  man ;  whose  heart 
departeth  from  the  Lord;  but  blessed  are 
they  that  put  their  trust  in  him. 

VI.  As  praise  and  thanksgiving  are  of- 
fered to  him. 

Daily  shall  He  be  praised  (Ps.  Ixxii.  15). 
Unto  Him  that  loved  us,  and  washed  us  from 
our  sins,  be  glorj'and  dominion  for  ever  and 
ever !  (Eev.  i.  5,  6 ;  compare  Ps.  cxlviii.  13). 
Let  them  praise  the  name  of  the  Lord,  for 
His  name  alone  is  excellent.  Whosoever 
shall  call  on  the  name  of  the  Lord  shall  be 
saved.  Saints,  with  all  that  in  every  place 
call  upon  the  name  of  Jesus  Christ  (1  Cor. 
i.  2,  and  Rev.  v.  11-13).  Worthy  is  the 
Lamb  that  was  slain,  to  receive  honour,  aud 
glory,  and  blessing — blessing  and  honour  and 
glory  and  power  be  unto  Him  that  sitteth 
upon  the  throne,  and  unto  the  Lamb,  for 
ever  and  ever.  Salvation  to  our  God,  who 
sitteth  upon  the  throne,  and  unto  the  Lamb. 
Blessing,  &c.,  be  unto  our  God  for  ever  and 
ever.     Amen.     (Rev.  vii.  10-12.) 

The  Holy  Ghost  is  God. 

L  In  regard  to  title. 

The  Spirit  of  the  Lord  spake  by  me — the 
God  of  Israel  said,  the  Rook  of  Israel  spake 
(2  Sam.  xxiii.  2,  3).  That  holy  thing  which 
shall  be  born  of  thee  shall  be  called  the  Son 
of  God  (St.  Luke  i.  35).  She  was  found  with 
child  of  the  Holy  Ghost  (St.  Matt.  i.  18). 
Teach  all  nations,  baptizing  them  in  the 
name  of  the  Father,  and  of  the  Son,  and  of 
the  Holy  Ghost  (St.  Matt,  xxviii.  19)  ;  which 
proves  equality  of  the  three  Persons.  Why 
has  Satan  filled  thine  heart  to  lie  to  the  Holy 
Ghost — thou  hast  lied  unto  God   (Acts  v. 


GOD-PARENTS 


3G7 


3,  4).  Born  of  the  Spirit  (St.  John  iii.  6). 
Be  born  of  God  (1  St.  John  v.  4).  Consider, 
too,  no  man  taketh  his  honour  to  himself, 
but  he  that  is  called  of  God  (Heb.  v. 
4).  The  Holy  Ghost  said.  Separate  mo 
Barnabas  and  Saul  for  the  work  where- 
unto  I  have  called  them. — So  they,  being 
sent  forth  by  the  Holy  Ghost,  departed 
(Acts  xiii.  2,  4).  They  shall  be  all  taught 
of  God  (St.  John  vi.  45).  Not  in  the  words 
which  man's  wisdom  teacheth,  but  which 
the  Holy  Ghost  teacheth  (1  Cor.  ii.  13). 
Ye  are  the  temple  of  God  (1  Cor.  iii.  16). 
Your  body  is  the  temple  of  the  Holy  Ghost 
(vi.  19).  The  hand  of  the  Lord  God  fell 
there  upon  me,  and  he  put  forth  the  form 
of  an  hand,  and  took  me  by  a  lock  of  mine 
head,  and  the  Spirit  lifted  me  up  (Ezek.  viii. 
1-3). 

See  also  the  following  passages,  as  re- 
spectively explaining  each  other :  St.  Luke 
ii.  26,  with  St.  John  xiv.  16,  17,  and  1  Cor. 
xiv.  25. — St.  Matt.  iv.  1,  with  St.  Luke  xi. 
4.-2  Cor.  i.  3,  with  Acts  ix.  31  St.  John 
xiv.  26,  &c.— 1  Cor.  ii.  11,  with  14;  1  Cor. 
iii.  16.— St.  Matt.  iv.  7,  with  Acts  v.  9. — 
Gen.  vi.  3,  with  1  St.  Pet.  iii.  20.— St.  Luke 
xi.  20,  with  St.  Matt.  xii.  28.— Acts  iv.  24, 
25,  with  i.  16,— and  St.  Luke  i.  68,  70,  with 
Acts  xxviii.  25 ;  and  various  others  that 
might  be  noticed. 

GOD-PARENTS.  Those  who  take  the 
child  to  the  baptismal  font  and  answer  for 
him  or  her.  They  are  also  called  Sponsors, 
and  Sureties ;  and  are  of  three  sorts :  those 
who  at  a  Baptism  answer — 1.  For  an  infant ; 
2.  For  an  adult  person  who  through  sick- 
ness or  other  impediment  cannot  speak  for 
himself;  3.  Who  are  witnesses  at  the 
Baptism  of  an  adult  person  who  can  answer 
for  himself.  They  are  called  Godfather  aud 
Godmother  "  that  the  New  Birth  may  be 
better  represented  by  new  and  spiritual 
relations  " :  Sponsors,  from  making  the  re- 
sponses on  behalf  of  the  infant ;  Sureties,  from 
the  surety  or  pledge  they  give  that  the 
child  shall  know  its  obUgations  and  be  put 
in  the  way  of  fulfiUing  them  (Comber, 
Works,  vol.  iii.). 

The  custom  of  having  God-parents  or 
Sponsors  for  children  is  of  very  ancient  date 
in  the  Church,  though  the  number  required 
has  varied :  TertuUian  (a.d.  192)  refers  to 
it.  In  the  office  for  Publick  Baptism  of 
Infants  the  third  Rubric  directs,  "  There 
shall  be  for  every  male  child  to  be  Baptized 
two  Godfathers  and  one  Godmother,  and  for 
every  female  one  Godfather  and  two  God- 
mothers." The  29th  Canon  directs  that, 
"  No  parent  shall  be  urged  to  be  present  or 
admitted  to  answer  as  Godfather  for  his 
own  child ;  nor  any  Godfather  or  God- 
mother shall  be  sufiered  to  make  any  other 
answer  or    speech   than  by   the  Book  of 


368 


GOD'S  BOAED 


Common  Prayer  is  prescribed  in  that  behalf. 
Neither  shall  any  person  be  admitted  God- 
father or  Godmother  to  any  child  at  Chris- 
tening or  Confirmation  before  the  said 
person  so  undertaking  hath  received  the 
Holy  Communion."  "  In  1865  the  Convo- 
cation of  the  Province  of  Canterbury,  with 
the  Royal  licence,  framed  a  new  canon 
which  repealed  the  prohibition  to  parents 
of  being  God-parents  to  their  children.  This 
canon  has,  however,  never  been  ratified  by 
the  Crown ;  and  no  such  canon  was  passed 
by  the  York  Convocation"  (Phillimore, 
Ecdes.  Law,  i.  642).  In  the  Eastern  and 
in  the  Latin  Church  one  Sponsor  only  was 
required  though  two  were  allowed,  and  this 
appears  to  have  been  the  early  practice  of 
the  Church  in  England.  The  present 
rubric  was  inserted  by  Bp.  Cosin  in  1661. 
Up  to  the  time  of  the  Council  of  Mainz, 
A.D.  813,  parents  were  not  forbidden  to 
act  as  Sponsors  for  their  children. 

The  God-parents'  duties  with  regard  to 
their  God-children  are  set  out  in  the  exhor- 
tation addressed  to  them  at  the  end  of  the 
Baptismal  Service,  and  are  briefly  these,  to 
see  that  the  child  is  brought  up  as  a  faithful, 
well-instnicted  member  of  the  Catholic 
Church,  and  that,  when  he  is  come  to  a 
competent  age,  and  is  so  instructed,  he  is 
brought  to  the  Bishop  to  be  confirmed  by 
him.  One  of  the  God-parents  is  further 
required  to  attend  the  Confirmation  as  a 
witness.  With  the  Confirmation  of  the 
child,  the  Sponsor's  duty  is  finished.  It 
may  be  worth  mentioning  a  common  error, 
viz.,  that  the  God-parent  is  responsible  for 
all  the  sins  of  the  God-child  up  to  the 
time  of  his  confirmation.  It  is  evident 
that  there  is  nothing  in  the  Prayer  Book  to 
sanction  this  idea,  which  nevertheless  holds 
back  many  persons  from  undertaking  "  this 
charitable  work."     [L.  P.] 

GOD'S  BOAED.  A  term  used  formerly 
for  the  altar.  "  y  charge  yow  that  no  man 
nother  woman,  that  he  goe  note  to  Oodd's 
bord,  lase  than  he  byleue  stedfastlych  that 
the  sacrament  that  he  ys  avysyd  here  to 
receue,  that  yt  ys  Godd's  body  flesche  and 
blode,  yn  the  forme  of  bred,  and  that  he 
receyvythe  afterward,  ys  no  thyng  ells  but 
wyne  and  water,  for  to  dense  your  mowthys 
of  the  holy  sacrament"  (Harleian  MS. 
2383).  It  is  so  called  in  the  rubiics  of  all 
the  Prayer  Books  before  1662.     [H.] 

GOLDEN  NUMBER  (See  Calendar). 
The  Golden  Numbers  run  from  1  to  19,  and 
are  placed  in  the  calendar  for  every  century 
against  some  19  days  out  of  the  3.5  from 
March  21  to  April  25,  on  which  the 
Paschal  moon  or  the  first  full  moon  after 
March  20  can  fall.  Those  days  vary  now 
in  different  centuries  since  the  change  of 
style.     Before  that  they  were  fixed,  as  may 


GOOD  FRIDAY 

be  seen  in  the  Table  of  Calendars  in  Sir  B. 
Beckett's  Astronomy  without  Mathematics, 
The  Golden  Number  for  the  year  is  found 
by  the  Gregorian  nile: — add  1  to  the 
year  and  divide  by  19,  and  the  remainder 
is  the  Golden  Number,  0  corresponding  to 
19  ;  and  that  with  the  table  shows  the  day 
of  Easter.  The  Prayer  Book  tables  are 
wrong  for  Old  Style.     [G.] 

GOOD  FRIDAY.  I.  "The  Friday  in 
Holy  week  received  this  name  from  the 
blessed  effects  of  our  Saviour's  sufferings, 
which  are  the  ground  of  all  our  joj',  and 
from  those  unspeakable  good  things  He  hath 
purchased  for  us  by  His '  death,  whereby 
the  blessed  Jesus  made  expiation  for  the 
sins  of  the  whole  world,  and  by  the  shed- 
ding of  His  own  blood,  obtained  eternal 
redemption  for  us."  The  day  has  been 
distinguished  at  different  times  by  various 
appellations,  as  fjiiepa  tov  (rravpot) ;  ircKrxa 
iTTavpaiiTilxov — the  Paschal  Day  of  the  Cruci- 
fixion, as  Easter  Day  was  called  wcurxa- 
dvaaTaaifiov ;  TrapacrKevrj  J  dies  Parasceves  (the 
day  of  preparation) ;  Feria  Sexta  Parasceves ; 
dies  Dominicaj  Passionis.  In  early  English 
times  it  was  called  Long  Friday  (^Elfric's 
Can.  37,  a.d.  957),  probably  on  account  of 
the  long  fasting  used;  but  its  present 
appellation  is  the  one  by  which  it  has  been 
popularly  known  for  many  centuries. 

The  commemoration  of  our  Saviour's 
sufferings  has  been  kept  from  the  very 
first  age  of  Christianity,  and  was  always 
observed  as  a  day  of  the  strictest  fasting 
humiliation.  The  fast  was  general,  not  con- 
fined to  those  who  professed  to  lead  a  life 
of  closer  devotion.  "  On  the  Paschal  Day," 
says  Tertullian,  "  the  strict  observance  of 
the  fast  is  general,  and  as  it  were  public  " 
(de  Orat.  xviii.) ;  and  it  was  extended :  for 
persons  wei'e  enjoined  to  fast,  if  they  could 
endure  it,  beyond  midnight  on  the  follow- 
ing day  {Apost.  Cunstit.  v.  18.).  The 
rigidity  of  the  fast  was  in  after  times 
broken,  "  Quidam  in  die  ejusdem  dominicai 
passionis  ab  hora  nona  jejunium  solvunt 
....  illi  jejunium  tanti  diei  polluunt, 
epulisque  inserviunt."  And  they  were  to  be 
punished  by  being  expelled  from  the  "  sacra- 
mental delight  of  Easter  "  (a  paschali  gaudio 
depellentur).  The  very  young,  the  very  old, 
and  the  sick  were  of  course  excepted  {Cone. 
Tolet.  iv.  viii.).  Other  observances  were 
adopted  to  mark  the  solemnity  of  the  day. 
The  kiss  of  peace,  an  emblem  used  in  the 
early  Church,  was  omitted  (TertuU.  u.  s.) : 
the  altar  was  made  bare :  no  chanting 
was  used  in  the  processions:  the  bells 
were  not  sounded  from  the  Wednesday 
till  the  Easter  morn ;  the  Reproaches  were 
said  (see  Reproaches)  :  and  a  cross,  blessed 
and  adored,  was  placed  in  front  of  the  altar. 
Muratori,  Ordo  Rom.  ii.  71-i ;  ibid.  Sacram. 


GOOD  FEIDAY 

Oelas.  i.  559).  The  cross,  after  much  cere- 
monial, was  held  before  the  altar  by  two 
deacons;  "prjeparetur  crux  ante  altare, 
interposito  spatio  inter  ipsam  et  altare, 
sustentata  hinc  inde  a  duobus  Diaconibus  " 
(Martene,  de  Ant.  Mon.  Rit.  torn.  iv.  lib.  iii. 
c.  14).  This  custom  was  observed  in  the 
English  Church  up  to  the  time  of  the  Kefor- 
mation  (see  Creeping  to  the  Cross);  but  it  was 
then  abolished  as  tending  to  superstition. 

II.  There  was  in  early  times  no  celebra- 
tion on  Good  Friday :  but  a  portion  of  the 
sacrament  in  one  element  only  having  been 
reserved  from  a  previous  celebration,  was 
placed  in  a  chalice  of  unconsecrated  wine, 
and  partaken  of  by  the  faithful.  This  was 
called  the  mass  of  the  pre-sanctified.  The 
reservation  was  in  the  Western  Church  gene- 
rally from  the  celebration  on  the  Maundy- 
Thursday,  which  on  that  day  alone  was 
at  a  late  service  (see  Fasting  before  Com- 
munion), but  in  the  Eastern  Church  no  cele- 
bration was  allowed  during  Lent  except  on 
Saturday,  the  Lord's  Day,  and  the  Feast 
of  the  Annunciation  {Cone.  Laodicea,  c.  49, 
circ.  A.D.  353 ;  Tnill.  c.  52).  (See  Missa 
Priesanctificatorum).  In  the  Roman  Church 
the  omission  of  celebration  is  limited  to  Good 
Friday  and  Easter  Bve ;  and  the  Priest  alone 
partakes  at  the  Missa  Prjesanctifioatorum. 
In  the  Church  of  England  there  is  no  re- 
striction ;  and  the  fact  of  the  appointment 
of  epistle  and  gospel  seems  to  show  that  a 
consecration  on  Good  Friday  to  supersede 
the  Mass  of  the  Presanctified  was  intended 
by  the  Reformers.  And  that  this  was  the 
practice  is  evident  from  Bishop  Andrewes' 
sermon  on  the  Passion. 

III.  Of  the  collects  for  Good  Friday  the 
fii-st  is  from  the  Sacramentary  of  Gregory  ; 
the  second  from  that  of  Gelasius ;  the 
third  is  based  upon  three  collects  found  in 
both  Sacramentaries.  The  epistle  (Heb.  x. 
1-25)  proves  from  the  insufficiency  of  the 
Jewish  sacrifices,  that  they  only  typified  a 
more  sufficient  one,  which  the  Son  of  God 
did,  as  on  this  day,  offer  up,  and  by  one 
oblation  of  himself  then  made  upon  the 
cross,  complete  all  the  other  sacrifices 
(which  were  only  shadows  of  this),  and 
made  full  satisfaction  for  the  sins  of  the 
whole  world.  In  imitation  of  which  Divine 
and  infinite  love,  the  Church  endeavours  to 
show  her  charity  to  be  boundless  and  un- 
limited, by  praying  in  one  of  the  proper 
collects,  that  the  effects  of  Christ's  death 
may  be  as  universal  as  the  design  of  it, 
namely,  that  it  may  tend  to  the  salvation 
of  all,  Jews,  Turks,  infidels,  and  heretics. 

In  St.  Augustine's  time  the  history  of  the 
Passion  was  read  from  St.  Matthew's  Gospel. 
St.  John's  account  was  probably  substituted 
for  the  Gospel  of  the  day  because  he  was 
the  only  one  that  was  present,  and  stood  by 


GOOD  WORKS 


369 


the  cross  while  others  fled  :  and  therefore, 
the  Passion  being  as  it  were  represented  be- 
fore our  eyes,  his  testimony  is  read  who 
saw  it  himself,  and  from  whose  example 
we  may  learn  not  to  be  ashamed  or  afraid 
of  the  cross  of  Christ.  The  proper  psalms 
(the  22nd,  as  St.  Augustine  tells  us,  hav- 
ing been  always  used  on  this  day  in  the 
African  Church)  and  both  the  second  lessons 
for  Good  Friday  were  added  at  the  revision 
of  1662.     [H.] 

GOOD  WORKS.  "  That  we  are  justified 
by  faith,  St.  Paul  tells  us ;  that  we  are  also 
justified  by  works,  we  are  told  in  St.  James  ii. 
24 ;  and  both  may  be  true.  But  that  this 
justification  is  wrought  by  faith  without 
works  '  to  him  that  worketh  not  but 
believeth,'  saith  St.  Paul :  that  this  is  not 
wrought  without  works,  St.  James  is  as 
express  for  his  negative  as  St.  Paul  was  for 
his  affirmative ;  and  how  both  these  should 
be  true,  it  is  something  harder  to  unriddle. 
But '  affirmanti  incumbit  probatio,'  therefore 
St.  Paul  proves  his  doctrine  by  the  example 
of  Abraham,  to  whom  faith  was  imputed 
for  righteousness;  and,  therefore,  not  by 
works.  And  what  can  be  answered  to  this  ? 
Nothing  but  this,  that  St.  James  uses  the 
very  same  argument  to  prove  that  our  justi- 
fication is  by  works  also;  'for  our  father 
Abraham  was  justified  by  works  when  he 
offered  up  his  son  Isaac'  Now  which  of 
these  says  true?  Certainly  both  of  them; 
but  neither  of  them  have  been  well  un- 
derstood; insomuch  that  they  have  not 
only  made  division  of  heart  among  the 
faithful,  but  one  party  relies  on  faith  to 
the  disparagement  of  good  life,  and  the  other 
makes  works  to  be  the  main  ground  of  our 
hope  and  confidence,  and  consequently  to 
include  the  efficacy  of  faith ;  the  one  makes 
the  Christian  religion  a  lazy  and  inactive  in- 
stitution ;  and  the  other  a  bold  presumption 
on  ourselves ;  one  looking  on  Christ  only  as 
a  lav.'giver,  and  the  other  only  as  a  Saviour. 
The  effects  of  these  are  very  sad,  and  by  all 
means  to  be  diverted  by  all  the  wise  con- 
siderations of  the  spirit"  (Jeremy  Taylor, 
Sermon  on  Faith :  "Fides  Formata,"  Works, 
vi.  p.  268,  Heher's  Ed.). 

The  controversies  on  this  subject  have  been 
too  numerous  to  be  entered  on  here :  the 
doctrine  of  the  Church  of  England  is  stated 
in  Articles  X.-XVI. :  especially  XII. 

"  Albeit  that  good  works,  which  are  the 
fruits  of  faith,  and  follow  after  justification, 
cannot  put  away  our  sins,  and  endure  the 
severity  of  God's  judgment ;  yet  are  they 
pleasing  and  acceptable  to  God  in  Christ, 
and  do  spring  out  necessarily  of  a  true  and 
lively  faith ;  insomuch  that  by  them  a  lively 
faith  may  be  as  evidently  kno^vn  as  a  tree 
discerned  by  the  frait." 

Good  works    are    inseparable    from  our 

2  B 


370 


GOSPEL 


union  with.  Christ ;  but  then  as  effects  of 
that  union,  not  as  causes  or  instruments. — 
Heurtley  (See  Faith,  Freewill,  Grace,  Jus- 
tification). 

GOSPEL.  I.  A  word  compounded  of  two 
Saxon  words,  god, "  Grod,"  and  spell,  a  story, 
or  history,  and  so  God's  narrative,  i.e.  the 
life  of  Christ;  or  possibly  the  story  (sc.  of 
salvation)  sent  from  God.  It  has  been 
commonly  understood  as  "good  spell," 
"good  tidings,"  and  so  equivalent  to 
rfayytXioj/ ;  but  this  is  not  correct. 

IL  In  a  stricter  sense,  the  word  means 
each  of  the  four  histories  of  our  Saviour, 
written  by  the  Evangelists :  in  a  more  con- 
fined sense  still,  it  means  that  portion  of 
Scripture  which  is  read  immediately  after 
the  Epistle  in  the  ante-communion  service, 
and  which  is  taken  from  one  of  the  four 
Gospels.  A  Gospel  is  also  read  in  the 
Baptismal  Service. 

III.  In  the  English  Church  before  the  Re- 
formation there  were  peculiar  ceremonies 
used  in  honour  of  the  Grospel,  as  for  in- 
stance, the  bringing  special  lights  even 
during  day-time,  placing  the  book  of  the 
Gospels  reverently  on  the  altar,  incensing 
it,  &c.,  though  St.  Jerome  says  that  in  his 
time  there  was  no  carrying  of  lights  before 
the  Gospel  in  the  Western  Church. 

The  versicle  "  Glory  be  to  Thee,  0  Lord," 
sung  before  the  reading  of  the  Gospel,  was 
printed  in  the  first  Prayer  Book,  of  1549 
(but  in  no  other),  having  been  traditionally 
retained  from  the  ancient  Church. 

IV.  It  was  always  the  rule  and  the 
rubric  directs  the  people  to  stand  at  the 
reading  of  the  Gospel ;  which  rule  is  men- 
tioned by  the  author  of  the  Apost.  Constit. 
(ii.  57);  and  St.  Chrysostom  speaks  of 
"  standing  up  with  attentive  ears  when  the 
letters,  not  of  an  earthly  king,  but  of  the 
Lord  of  Angels,  are  read  to  us  {Horn.  i.  in 
Matt.).  St.  Augustine  also  refers  to  the 
custom  {Horn,  xxvi),  but  he  speaks  of  all  the 
people  standing  whenever  any  Scripture  was 
read.  In  Egypt  the  monks  sat  during  the 
reading  of  the  Gospel ;  but  this  was  allowed 
because  of  their  excessive  fastings  and 
watchings;  and  it  was  remarked  as  an 
isolated  and  strange  case  that  the  Bishop  of 
Ale.'iandria  did  not  rise  at  that  time  (Soz. 
vii.  19).  With  regard  to  this  custom 
Hooker  says :  "  It  showeth  a  reverend  re- 
gard to  the  Son  of  God  above  all  other 
messengers,  although  speaking  as  from  God 
also.  And  against  Infidels,  Jews,  Arians 
who  derogate  from  the  honour  of  Jesus 
Christ,  such  ceremonies  are  most  profitable." 
— Bingham,  bk.  xiv.  c.  3 ;  Annot.  P.  B.  ii. 
160.     [H.] 

GOSPELLER.  The  minister  who  in  the 
Communion  Service  reads  the  Gospel,  stand- 
in"'  at  the  north  side  of  the  altar,  facing 


GOTHIC 

the  people  (See  North  Side).  In  some 
cathedrals  one  of  the  clergy  is  so  designated, 
and  has  this  special  duty  among  others  to 
perform.  In  primitive  times  the  Epistle 
and  Gospel  were  read  from  pulpits  called 
Ambones  which  stood  on  opposite  sides  of 
the  choir  immediately  within  the  entrance. 
By  the  24th  Canon,  in  cathedral  and  colle- 
giate churches,  a  Gospeller  (as  well  as  an 
Epistoler)  is  to  assist  the  priest,  vested  in  a 
cope.  Gospellers  are  statutable  members  of 
the  several  cathedrals  of  the  new  foundation, 
and  an  officer  so  called  still  officiates  at 
Durham  ;  contrary  to  the  ancient  universal 
usage  of  the  Church,  even  when  many 
priests  and  deacons  are  present,  it  was  usual, 
till  lately,  for  but  two  ministers  to  attend  at 
the  first  part  of  the  Communion  Service; 
the  principal  minister  reading  the  Gospel. 
But  generally  the  ancient  custom  is  being 
revived.  In  the  ordering  of  deacons,  authority 
is  given  them  to  "  rmd  the  Gospel  in  the 
Church  of  God." — Jebb,  Choral  Service, 
p.  480  (See  Epistoler). 

GOSSIP.  A  sponsor  for  an  infant  in 
baptism,  from  God  and  sib,  a  Saxon  word, 
which  signifies  kindred,  affinity :  kin  in 
God.  All  god-children  of  one  person,  or 
even  of  a  man  and  his  wife,  were  called 
God-sib,  and  within  the  prohibited  degrees 
of  the  Roman  Church,  so  far  as  to  have  to 
buy  a  dispensation  to  enable  them  to 
marry  (See  God-parents). 

GOTHIC.  A  general  term  for  that  style  of 
medifeval  architecture  of  which  the  pointed 
arch  is  the  most  prominent  character.  To- 
gether with  Romanesque  (an  equally  general 
term  for  that  style  of  which  the  round  arch 
is  the  most  prominent  character)  it  com- 
prehends all  medieval  ecclesiastical  archi- 
tecture in  England.  The  substyles  with 
their  dates  may  be  roughly  stated  as 
follows : 


Romanesque- 
Saxon     . 
Norman. 
Transition 


1066 
1066-1145 
1145-1190 

1190-1245 
1245-1315 
1315-1360 
1360-1550 


Gothic — 

Early  English         .        . 
Geometrical    . 
Decorated 
Perpendicular 

The  more  minute  characteristics  must  be 
sought  under  these  several  names,  and  it 
must  be  obvious  that  the  accounts  given 
within  the  small  limits  we  can  devote  to 
the  subject  must  be  very  superficial.  The 
subject  may  be  pursued  in  a  number  of 
works  now  before  the  public,  as,  first  in 
date  and  not  last  in  importance,  Rickman's 
"  Attempt  to  distinguish  the  Styles  of 
Architecture  In  England,"  and  Sharpe's 
"  Seven  Periods  of  English  Architecture." 
Sir  G.  Scott  advocated  the  Early  Decorated 
style  as  the  climax  to  which  all  other  styles 


GOWN, 

converged,  and  from  which  they  diverged 
again.  The  following  diagrams  will  be 
useful  as  giving  generally  the  terms  used  in 
Gothic  Architecture. 


GOWN 


371 


and  Puritanism  (the  preaching  gown)  and 
so  establish  uniformity  in  the  only  way  now 
possible,"  instead  of  keeping  up  a  very 
doubtful   piece  of  ritualism  of  their  own, 


Exterior, 
A.  Aisle. 

L  Basement. 

II.  Parapet. 

a.  Corbel  table. 
5.  Cornice. 

c.  Gurgoyle. 

III.  Buttress. 

d.  Pedimental  set-off. 
e.  Plain  set-off. 

/.  Finial. 

g.  Flying-buttress,  or  arch- 
buttress. 

IV.  Aisle  rooL 
<3.  Clearstory. 


Interior. 

A.  Aisle. 

V.  Pier. 

A.  Capital, 
fc.  Base. 
VI.  Pier  arch, 

m.  Spandril, 
Vn,  Taulting  shaft, 

n.  Corljel,         v. 

B,  Triforium. 

VIIL  Triforium  arcade, 
p.  Blank  arches, 
q.  Pierced  arches, 

C,  Clearstory. 

D.  Vault. 

r.  Groining  ribs, 
s.  Bosses, 


t.  Shaft 
I.  Band, 


Capital , 


COMMOX  TO  EXTEBIOR  AND  ISTERIOR. 

E,  Aisle  windows, 

(.  Jfimb  .ihaftB. 
u.  Tracery  (Perpendicular). 
V.  MuUions.  vj.  Transom, 

X,  Basement  lights, 

F,  Clearstory  windows.    . 

y.  Tracery  (Geometrical,^ 

z,  Cusping  or  foliation, 

aa.  Tracery  (Flowing), 

hi).  Hood  in  the  exterior,  more 

correctly  dripstone. 
cc.  Corbel,  or  label. 

Decorations  common  to  both, 

1,  Arcading  (Norman  to  Decorated), 

2,  Panelling  (Perpendicular), 

3,  Nich,         4,  Panel,         6,  String, 


GOWN.  It  is  odd  that  among  the 
many  ritualistic  questions  that  have  been 
litigated  and  decided,  that  of  gown  v.  surplice 
in  preaching  has  not  yet  been  tried : 
consequently  we  do  not  profess  to  state 
the  law  upon  it  with  confidence.  We  are 
inclined  to  repeat  the  conclusions  of  the 
Quarterly  Review  of  Jan.  1881,  p.  207,  that 
if  it  did  come  to  be  litigated  the  Privy 
Council  would  probably  find  its  way  to 
deciding  that  either  garment  is  legal ;  but 
that  "  the  current  has  now  run  so  long  and 
increasingly  in  favour  of  the  surplice  among 
clergymen  who  are  not  the  least  ritualistic, 
that  those  who  find  themselves  at  last  the 
champions  of  the  Act  of  Uniformity  had 
better  drop  that  odd  compound  of  Popery 


which  is  unquestionably  not  prescribed  any- 
where, if  it  is  permitted  by  silence.  The 
principal  argument  against  it  axA  prima  facie 
conclusive,  is,  that  according  to  the  decision 
in  the  Bidsdale  case  the  surplice  (with  hood 
and  tippet  of  the  Canons)  is  the  only  vest- 
ment to  be  worn  in  all  times  of  their  minis- 
trations in  church ;  and  it  is  difficult  to  make 
out  that  a  part  of  the  prescribed  sei-vice  in 
church  is  not "  a  time  of  their  ministration." 
The  arguments  against  this  are  in  fact  so 
minute  and  ingenious  that  we  could  not 
represent  them  in  any  language  but  their 
authors',  which  is  too  long  to  quote,  and  so 
we  refer  to  Archdeacon  Harrison's  and  Canon 
Eobertson's  books  on  the  Liturgy  for  them. 
Historically  they  have  a  more  intelKgible 

2  E  2 


372 


GKAOE 


case,  and  one  of  no  small  weight,  in  the  fact 
that  for  a  long  time,  at  any  rate,  none  but 
members  of  a  cathedral  or  collegiate  corpora- 
tion ever  preached  in  such  churches  in  a 
surplice.  But,  per  contra,  they  very  seldom 
preached  at  all  there  until  quite  recent  times. 
The  same  custom  prevailed  in  nearly  all 
town  churches  till  lately.  But  again,  in 
those  times  the  preacher  generally  took  no 
part  in  the  service  before  the  sermon,  but  sat 
in  a  pew  like  the  rest  of  the  consregation. 
The  fact  that  preachers  in  the  University 
churches  always  wore  a  gown  goes  for  no- 
thing, because  those  sermons  ware  not  part  of 
the  church  service,  but  rather  of  the  nature 
of  the  sermons  at  Paul's  Cross  and  any 
similar  places.  There  were  multitudes 
of  country  churches  where  long  before 
modern  ritualism  no  one  ever  saw  the  single 
clergyman  change  his  surpUoe  for  a  gown. 
That  might  be  accounted  for  by  either 
poverty  or  laziness,  no  doubt ;  but  until 
some  general  injunction  or  early  universal 
use  of  the  gown  is  established,  it  is  illogical 
to  impute  the  absence  of  it  to  those  causes. 
It  is  much  more  probable  evidence  of 
ancient  use  never  superseded. 

Another  difficulty,  to  which  we  have 
never  seen  any  answer,  is  that  no  single 
rubric,  canon.  Act  of  Parliament,  Injunction 
or  Advertisement,  ever  recognised  the  gown 
as  a  ministering  or  church  dress.  They 
were  prescribed  as  walking  dress,  and  used 
so  until  modem  times ;  and  it  is  remarkable 
that  what  used  to  be  called  the  "  preaching 
gown,"  with  "  pudding  sleeves,"  is  stiU  the 
Court  dress  for  clergymen,  who  are  not  re- 
ceived there  in  M.A.  gowns ;  and  the  Cam- 
bridge LL.D.  gown  only  appears  at  Court 
on  Queen's  Counsel  and  Judges.  Conse- 
quently, if  a  gown  is  a  lawful  dress  in  the 
pulpit,  we  do  not  see  how  any  special  dress 
at  all  is  compulsory  there.  On  the  whole 
we  can  come  to  no  other  conclusion,  except 
from  the  usage  which  has  nearly  disappeared 
again,  than  that  the  gown  in  the  pulpit  is 
what  the  Quarterly  Beview  called  it,  a  com- 
pound of  Popery  (for  Popish  priests  some- 
times at  least  use  it)  and  the  old  puritanical 
animosity  against  the  surplice  as  a  minister- 
ing dress  at  all.    [G.] 

GrKACE.  This  word  is  used  in  a  variety 
of  senses  in  Holy  Scripture :  but  the  general 
idea,  as  it  relates  to  God,  is  His  free  favour 
and  love ;  as  it  relates  to  men,  the  happy 
state  of  reconciliation  and  favour  with  God, 
wherein  they  stand,  and  the  holy  endow- 
ments, qualities,  or  habits  of  faith,  hope,  and 
love,  which  they  possess. 

The  most  pious  of  those  who  lived  under 
the  Mosaic  dispensation,  often  acknowledge 
the  necessity  of  assistance  from  God.  David 
prays  to  God  to  "  open  his  eyes,  to  guide  and 
direct  him  "  (Ps.  cxix.  18, 32-35) ;  to  "  create 


GRACE 

in  him  a  clean  heart,  and  renew  a  right 
spirit  within  him"  (Ps.  U.  10).  And  Solo- 
mon says,  that  God  "  directeth  men's  paths, 
and  giveth  grace  to  the  lowly."  Even  we, 
whose  minds  are  enlightened  by  the  pure 
precepts  of  the  gospel,  and  influenced  by 
the  motives  which  it  suggests,  must  still  be 
convinced  of  our  weakness  and  depravity, 
and  of  the  necessity  of  Divine  grace  to 
regulate  and  strengthen  our  wills,  and  to 
co-operate  with  our  endeavours  after  right- 
eousness, as  is  clearly  asserted  in  the  New 
Testament.  See  the  texts  above  cited,  which 
sufBciently  prove  that  we  stand  in  need  both 
of  a  preventing  and  of  a  co-operating  grace  ; 
or,  in  the  words  of  the  Article,  that  "we 
have  no  power  to  do  good  works  pleasant 
and  acceptable  to  God,  without  the  grace  of 
God  by  Christ  preventing  us,  that  we  may 
have  a  good  will,  and  working  with  us,  when 
we  have  that  good  will." 

Dr.  Nicholls,  after  quoting  many  author- 
ities to  show  that  the  doctrine  of  Divine 
grace  always  prevailed  in  the  Catholic 
Church,  adds,  "  I  have  spent  perhaps  more 
time  in  these  testimonies  than  was  absolutely, 
necessary;  but  whatever  I  have  done  is  to 
show,  that  the  doctrine  of  Divine  grace  is 
so  essential  a  doctrine  of  Christianity,  that 
not  only  the  Holy  Scriptures  and  the  primi- 
tive Fathers  assert  it,  but  likewise  that  the 
Christians  could  not  in  any  age  maintain 
their  religion  without  it ;  it  Ijeing  necessarj', 
not  only  for  the  discharge  of  Christian  duties, 
but  for  the  performance  of  our  ordinary, 
devotions."  And  this  seems  to  have  been' 
the  opinion  of  the  compilers  of  our  most 
excellent  liturgy,  in  many  parts  of  which 
both  a  preventing  and  co-operating  grace  is 
unequivocally  acknowledged;  particularly 
in  the  second  collect  for  Evening  Service,  in 
the  fourth  collect  at  the  end  of  the  Com- 
munion Service,  and  in  the  collects  for  Easter 
Day,  for  the  fifth  Sunday  after  Easter,  and 
for  the  3rd,  9th,  17th,  19th,  and  25th  Sun- 
days after  Trinity. 

"  This  assistance  of  Divine  grace  is  not  in- 
consistent vpith  the  free  agency  of  men  (see 
Free  Will)  :  it  does  not  place  them  under  an 
irresistible  restraint,  or  compel  them  to  act 
contrary  to  their  will.  Though  human 
nature  is  greatly  depraved,  yet  every  good 
disposition  is  not  totally  extinguished,  nor 
is  all  power  of  right  action  entirely  annihil- 
ated. Men  may  therefore  make  some 
spontaneous,  though  feeble,  attempt  to  act 
conformably  to  their  duty,  which  wUl  be, 
promoted  and  rendered  effectual  by  the  co- 
operation of  God's  grace;  or  the  grace  of 
God  may  so  far  'prevent'  our  actual  en- 
deavours, as  to  awaken  and  dispose  us  to 
our  duty ;  but  yet  not  in  such  a  degree,  that' 
we  cannot  mthstand  its  influence.  In 
either  case  our  own  exertions  are  necessary  to 


GKAOB  AT  MEALS 

enable  us  to  'work  out  our  own  salvation,' 
but  om-  '  sufficiency '  for  that  purpose  is 
from  God.  The  joint  agency  of  God  and 
man.  in  the  work  of  human  salvation  is 
pointed  out  in  the  following  passage  : 
'  Work  out  your  own  salvation  with  fear 
and  trembling ;  for  it  is  Gtod  that  worketh 
in  you  both  to  will  and  to  do  of  his  good 
pleasure'  (Phil.  ii.  12,  13);  and  therefore 
we  may  assure  ourselves  that  free  will  and 
grace  are  not  incompatible,  though  the  mode 
and  degree  of  their  co-operation  be  utterly 
inexplicable." — Bishop  Tomline's  Elements 
of  Christ.  Theol.  vol.  ii.  p.  250  seq. 

GRACE  AT  MEALS.  A  short  prayer, 
invoking  a  blessing  upon  our  food,  and 
expressive  of  gratitude  to  God  for  supplying 
our  wants.  The  propriety  of  this  act  is 
evident  from  the  traditional  custom  of  the 
Church,  and  from  the  Divine  command,  as 
interpreted  by  this  custom  (1  Thess.  v.  18 ; 
1  Cor.  X.  31 ;  1  Tim.  iv.  5),  and  from  the 
conduct  of  our  Lord  (Mark  viii.  6,  7). 

GEADUAL,  or  GKAIL.  A  psalm  or 
portion  of  a  psalm,  sung  after  the  Epistle. 
Then  the  book  containing  these  anthems 
was  called  the  Gradale,  or  Graduale ;  which 
term  was  afterwards  extended  and  included 
other  portions  ol  the  service  of  the  Holy 
Eucharist.  A  Gradale  was  one  of  the  books 
ordered  in  the  Constitution  of  Archbishop 
Winchelsey.  It  is  to  be  distinguished  from 
the  Antiphoner,  the  latter  belonging  to  the 
service  of  the  Hours,  the  former  to  the  Mass. 
— Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  i.  xxxix. 

G  HAD  CJ  AL  PSALMS.  Psalms  of  degrees, 
or  the  "15  Psalms"  (119-134).  Several 
reasons  have  been  given  for  the  tenn  (Pole, 
torn.  ii.  1318),  but  the  most  common  is  that 
they  were  sung  on  the  fifteen  steps  of  the 
Temple.  "  They  were  probably  written  by 
David  as  part  of  that  preparation  which  he 
made  for  the  buUding  of  the  Temple,  and  for 
the  Divine  service  to  be  carried  on  there." — 
Blunt's  P.  B.  ii.  496 ;  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit. 
iii.  95.  The  explanation  however  adopted 
by  the  majority  of  critics  now  is  that  they 
were  sung  by  Israelites  "going  up"  to 
Jerusalem,  either  on  their  return  from 
exile,  or  on  the  pilgrimage  for  the  national 
festivals.  In  the  revised  version  of  the  Old 
Testament  they  are  termed  "Songs  of 
Ascents."     [H.] 

GRAVE.  The  resting-place  of  a  dead 
body.  The  spoliation  and  desecration  of 
ancient  sepulchres  is  as  much  an  ecclesias- 
tical offence  as  the  robbing  of  a  more  recent 
grave;  but  where  none  feel  themselves 
especially  aggrieved,  there  are  none  to  seek 
redress,  and  to  bring  offenders  to  justice. 
The  law  upon  the  subject  seems  to  stand 
thus :  a  corpse  once  buried  cannot  legally 
be  taken  up  to  be  deposited  in  another 
place,  without  a  licence  from  the  ordinary, 


GREGORIAN  CHANT 


373 


or  an  order  of  the  Secretary  of  State  in  some 
oases.  But  in  case  of  a  violent  death  the 
coroner  may  order  the  body  to  be  disinterred, 
if  it  has  been  buried  before  he  has  had  an 
opportunity  of  taking  a  view  for  the  purposes 
of  his  inquest.  If  the  body  be  disturbed  or 
removed,  it  is  a  subject  of  ecclesiastical  cog- 
nizance :  yet  the  common  law  also  protects 
the  corpse ;  for  the  taking  up  of  dead  bodies, 
for  the  purposes  of  dissection,  is  an  indictable 
offence,  as  highly  indecent,  and  contra  honos 
mores.*  The  property  of  things  deposited 
with  the  dead,  as  the  grave-clothes,  &c.,  is  in 
him  that  had  property  therein  when  the  dead 
body  was  wrapped  therewith,  and  the  taking 
them  is  felony.  The  property  in  hatch- 
ments, or  other  ensigns  ot  honour,  is  in  the 
heir,  or  the  person  concerned  in  the  heredit- 
ary distinction  (See  Burial,  and  the  list  of 
Acts  of  Parliament  appended  to  the  word 
Cemetery). 

GREEK  CHUECH  (See  Church,  Greek). 

GEEGORIAN  CHANT  (See  Chant). 
This  general  designation  is  given  to  the 
collection  of  chants  compiled  by  Gregory 
the  Great,  bishop  of  Eome,  about  a.d.  GOO. 
These  chants  have  continued  to  be  in  use 
from  that  time  to  the  present  day,  in  the 
Western  Church,  and  form  the  basis  of  our 
cathedral  music.  It  is  known  that  Gregory 
merely  collected,  arranged,  and  improved 
the  chants  which  had  already  been  used  for 
centuries  before  his  time.  They  are  derived 
from  those  introduced  by  St.  Ambrose  into 
his  church,  at  Milan,  about  a.d.  384. 
Great  improvements,  however,  having  bsen 
made  in  the  science  of  music,  subsequently 
to  the  time  of  St.  Ambrose,  Gregory  took 
advantage  of  those  improvements,  and  in- 
creased the  number  of  ecclesiastical  tones. 
The  four  scales  admitted  by  Ambrose  called 
the  Dorian,  Phrygian,  Lydian,  and  Mixo- 
Lydian,  modifications  of  the  Greek  scales, 
correspond  to  our  scales  of  D,  E,  F,  G, 
without  any  accidentals :  the  melodies 
written  in  each  ranging  only  from  the  key- 
note to  its  octave  ending  properly  on  the 
keynote  thence  called  the  final.  To  each 
of  these  Gregory  added  a  subordinate  scale, 
with  the  prefix  vjro — hypo,  e.g.  hypo-Dorian, 
&c.,  each  being  a  fourth  below  the  original. 
The  only  accidental  admitted  was  the  B 
flat.  The  four  original  tones  are  called 
authentic,  the  others  plagal.  All  the  eight 
are  now  used  in  some  parts  of  the  Greek 
Church,  as  in  Russia,  doubtless  adopted 
from  the  West.  They  have  been  har- 
monized according  to  the  more  recently 
discovered  laws  of  music,  and  thus  har- 
monized possess  a  singular  gravity,  which 
character  would  alone  justify  their  retention 
in  the  Church  as  the  basis  of  church  music. 

*  It  ha8  been  decided  that  dead  bodies  are  not  pro- 
perty.   [G.] 


374 


GEEGOEIAN  CHANT 


The  Gregorian  chant  is  not  limited  to 
psalm  chants ;  it  includes  the  antiphons, 
versicles,  graduals,  &c., — in  short,  aU  the 
hymns  at  the  various  services  of  the  Roman 
Church.  The  eight  tones  (which  are  by 
some  multiplied  to  twelve)  are  in  fact  so 
many  scales,  and  all  the  Gregorian  hymns 
or  anthems  must  be  written  in  one  or  other 
of  these  tones.  The  ancient  Gregorian  scale 
admitted  no  half  notes,  with  the  exception 
of  B  flat.  The  psalm  chants  had  con- 
siderable variation  in  each  tone ;  these 
variations  occm'ring  in  the  second  part  of 
the  chant :  thus  one  tone  may  have  three 
or  four  endings ;  which  in  fact  form  so 
many  separate  chants  (See  Chant).  Much 
of  the  old  English  church  music,  since  the 
Eeformatton,  is  based  ujwn  the  Gregorian 
chant :  though  none  of  our  standard  mu- 
sicians were  ever  servile  followers  of  a  sys- 
tem, which,  though  very  venerable,  is  im- 
perfect. 

It  may  be  as  well  to  subjoin  a  simple 
rule  for  ascertaining  the  tones  in  which  the 
Gregorian  music  is  written  in  the  old  books. 
In  the  ancient  breviaries  and  antiphonaries, 
&c.,  the  word  EVOVAE  frequently  occurs, 
written  imder  certain  notes  preceding  the 
psalms  appropriated  to  certain  offices.  This 
word  contains  the  vowels  of  the  concluding 
words  of  the  Gloria  Patri ;  viz.  sEcVlOrVm 
AmEn:  and  by  this  is  meant,  that  the 
notes  placed  above  it  form  the  second  part 
(if  the  chant  to  which  the  following  psalm 
or  psalms  are  sung:  the  first  part  being 
rarely  written.  Now,  to  find  the  tone  of 
the  chant,  we  must  take  the  first  note  of 
the  Evovae,  which  is  the  dominant,  or  the 
prevailing,  or  reciting  note  of  the  chant  (not 
the  dominant  as  now  technically  under- 
stood by  musicians)  :  and  we  must  take  the 
last  note  of  the  antiphon  which  follows  the 
Psalm  at  length :  and  these  two,  according 
to  the  table  here  subjoined,  give  the  tone 
of  the  chant :  the  first  part  of  each  varia- 
tion in  tone  being,  as  before  remarked, 
always  the  same ;  the  second  part  being 
given  in  the  Mvovae.  The  Psalm  Tones 
must  be  founri  out  in  one  of  the  many 
movements  of  the  Gregorian  chant.  Care 
must  be  taken  not  to  lake  the  last  note  of 
the  abbreviated  antiphon  which  precedes, 
but  of  that  which  follows,  the  psalm. 


Final  note,  in  the 
Antiphon. 

Dominant  or  re- 

ciiinK  note  in  the 

Evovue. 

1st  Tone. 

D 

A 

2nd  Tone. 

D 

F 

3rd  Tone. 

E 

C 

4  th  Tone. 

E 

A 

5(h  Tone. 

F 

C 

Cth  Tone. 

F 

A 

7th  Tone. 

G 

D 

8th  Tone. 

G 

C 

GEEY  PEIAES 

Of  these  tones  the  odd  numbers  are  au- 
thentic, the  even  plagal.  The  authentic 
has  always  a  relation  to  its  plagal  which 
follows,  and  has  the  same  final  note,  though 
a  different  dominant. — Jebb,  Choral  Ser- 
vice, 273-294 ;  Blunt's  P.  B.  i.  Ivii. ;  Diet. 
Christ.  Ant.  (See  Music). 

GREGORY  I.  (THE  GREAT):  Bishop 
of  Rome :  commemorated  in  the  Calendar  on 
March  12.  Born  of  noble  parentage  at  Rome, 
A.D.  540,  he  began  his  public  career  as  a 
lawyer,  and  for  some  time  held  the  office  of 
Prjetor.  But  on  the  death  of  his  father  he 
gave  up  the  wealth  he  inherited  to  religious 
uses,  and  entered  the  order  of  St.  Benedict. 
He  was  made  Pope,  much  against  his  vrill, 
on  the  death  of  Pelagius,  in  590.  By  the 
extinction  of  the  Western  Empire  he 
became  not  only  Bishop  of  the  Roman 
Church  and  Patriarch  of  the  West,  but 
virtual  sovereign  of  Rome.  As  a  ruler  and 
organizer,  as  well  as  a  preacher  and  writer, 
he  was  undoubtedly  the  greatest  man  of  his 
age.  To  him  England  owes  the  mission  of 
St.  Augustine.  Gregory  himself  had  in 
previous  years  desired  to  go  to  the  far  West, 
as  it  was  then  considered,  to  preach  the 
Gospel.  This  desire  had  been  furthered  in 
his  mind  by  the  sight  of  some  captives 
standing  in  the  market-place  of  Rome. 
"  Who  are  these  ?  "  he  asked.  "  Angles," 
was  the  reply.  "  Truly,"  said  Gregory, 
"  they  are  angels.  From  what  province  ?  " 
"  Deira."  "  Truly  they  must  be  rescued 
de  ira — from  the  wrath  of  God.  What  is 
the  name  of  their  king  ?  "  "  iElla."  "  Yea," 
said  Gregory,  "Alleluia  must  be  sung  in 
the  dominions  of  that  king."  He  started 
on  his  mission,  but  was  recalled  by  the 
Pope,  who  could  not  spare  so  good  a  man. 
When  Pope  himself,  he  sent  out  St.  Augus- 
tine and  his  monks,  and  was  able  to  an- 
nounce to  the  Archbishop  of  Alexandria, 
two  years  afterwards,  that  they  had  baptized 
the  king  of  Kent  with  10,000  of  his  people. 
In  his  pontificate  the  Spanish  Visigoths  and 
the  Lombards  were  converted  from  Arianism, 
Church  music,  too,  received  a  great  impulse 
from  him,  and  "  Gregorian  tones,"  altered 
and  modified,  are  still  in  use.  Moreover,  his 
Sacramentary,  following  the  earlier  gne  of 
Gelasius,  is  a  great  storehouse  of  the  ancient 
liturgical  forms  of  the  Western  Church, 
from  which  our  Collects  are  largely  taken. 
While  thus  "  a  man  amongst  merr"  he  was 
of  remarkable  humility ;  he  disclaimed  the 
title  of  "  Universal  Bishop  "  (papa  univer- 
salis), and  preferred  that  of  "  Servant  of  the 
servants  of  God."  He  died  March  10,  a.d. 
604. — Milman's  Lat.  Christ,  vol.  i.  401,  sea.  ; 
Gibbon,  c.  xlv.     [H.] 

GREGORY,     SACRAMENTARY     OP 
(See  Sacravientaries). 

GREY  FRIARS.     The  Franciscans  were. 


GUARDIAN 

so  called  from  their  grey  clothing  (See 
Franciscans). 

GUARDIAN  OF  THE  SPIRITUAL- 
ITIES. This  is  the  person  or  persons  in 
whom  the  ecclesiastical  jurisdiction  of  any 
diocese  resides,  after  the  death  or  transla- 
tion of  a  bishop.  If  the  vacant  see  should 
tie  an  archbishopric,  then  the  dean  and 
chapter  are  guardians.  If  a  bishop,  then 
the  archbishop  of  the  province,  except  in  a 
few  cases,  where  the  dean  and  chapter  claim 
the  right  by  ancient  usage,  as  at  Durham 
and  Sahsbury. 

GUEGOILE  (See  Gargoyle). 


H. 

HABAKKUK,  THE  PROPHECY  OF. 
A  canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament. 
There  is  no  mention  in  Scripture,  either 
of  the  time  when  this  prophet  lived,  or  of 
the  parents  from  whom  he  was  descended. 
But  as  he  prophesied  the  coming  of  the 
Chaldeans  in  the  same  manner  as  Jeremiah, 
it  is  conjectured  that  he  lived  at  the  same 
time  (See  Smith's  Dictionary  of  the  Bible, 
s.  v.). 

HADES  (usually  derived  from  a, 
privative,  and  Ihdv,  to  see,  but  the  aspirate 
makes  this  very  doubtful).  The  invisible 
abode  of  departed  spirits  (See  Hell). 

HAGGAI,  THE  PROPHECY  OF.  A 
canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament. 
Haggai  was  bom,  according  to  tradition,  at 
Babylon,  from  whence  he  returned  with 
Zerubbabel.  It  was  this  prophet,  who,  by 
command  from  God,  exhorted  the  Jews, 
after  their  return  from  the  captivity,  to 
finish  the  rebuilding  of  the  temple,  which 
they  had  intermitted  for  fourteen  years. 
His  remonstrances  had  their  effect ;  and  to 
encourage  them  to  proceed  in  the  work,  he 
assured  them  from  God,  that  the  glory  of 
this  latter  house  should  be  greater  than 
the  glory  of  the  former  house :  which  was 
accordingly  fulfilled,  when  Christ  honoured 
it  with  His  presence ;  for,  with  respect  to 
the  building,  this  latter  temple  was  nothing 
in  comparison  of  the  former.  The  history 
of  this  period  of  twenty-one  years  is  con- 
tained in  the  book  of  Ezra,  a  portion  of 
which  has  been  ascribed  with  some  proba- 
bility to  the  pen  of  Haggai  (See  Diet,  of 
Bible,  s.  V.  Ezra). 

We  know  nothing  of  the  time  of  Haggai's 
death.  Epiphanius  asserts  that  he  was 
buried  at  Jerusalem  among  the  priests. 
The  Greeks  keep  his  festival  on  the  16th 
of  December,  and  the  Latins  on  the  4th  of 
July  (Sec  Speaker's  Commentary). 


HALF  COMMUNION 


375 


HAGIOGRAPHA:  Holy  Writings. 
(Fi'om  aytos,  Iwly,  and  ypa<pfi,  writing). 
A  word  of  great  antiquity  in  the  Christian 
Church,  and  often  used  by  St.  Jerome, 
taken  from  the  custom  of  the  synagogues, 
by  which  the  Old  Testament  was  divided 
into  three  parts,  viz.  Moses's  law,  the  Pro- 
phets, and  the  Hagiographa ;  in  which  last 
is  included  the  Psalms,  the  Proverbs,  Job, 
Ezra,  Chronicles,  Solomon's  Song,  Ruth, 
Ecclesiastes,  and  Esther.  The  Jews  reckon 
the  Book  of  Daniel  and  the  Lamentations 
among  the  Hagiographa,  and  not  among  the 
Prophets,  for  which  Theodoret  blames  them : 
but  it  matters  not  much,  since  they  acknow- 
ledge those  books,  which  they  call  Hagio- 
grapha, to  be  inspired  by  God,  and  part  of 
the  sacred  canon,  as  well  as  those  of  the  first 
and  second  order. — -Home's  Introduction, 
vol.  ii.  p.  162  ;  Bp.  Cosin's  Scholast.  Hist,  of 
the  Canon,  c.  ii.  p.  10  seq. 

It  is  to  be  observed  that  in  the  Jewish 
Hagiographa  or  Chethubim  (holy  writings), 
Daniel  is  excluded  from  the  number  of 
prophets,  and  that  his  writings,  with  the 
rest  of  the  Hagiographa,  were  not  publicly 
read  in  the  synagogues,  as  were  the  Law 
and  the  Prophets.  This  is  ascribed  to  the 
singular  minuteness  with  which  he  foretold 
the  coming  of  the  Messiah,  before  the  de- 
struction of  the  city  and  sanctuary  (Dan.  ix.), 
and  afterwards  to  the  apprehension  of  the 
Jews,  lest  the  public  reading  of  his  predic- 
tions should  lead  any  to  embrace  the  doc- 
trines of  Jesus  Christ. 

HAGIOSCOPE.  In  church  architec- 
ture, a  contrivance,  whether  by  perforating 
a  wall,  or  by  cutting  away  an  angle  of  it, 
by  which  an  altar  may  be  seen  from  some 
place  in  a  church,  or  about  it,  from  which 
it  would  be  otherwise  hid.  There  is  a 
most  curious  example  at  Ryhall  in  Rutland, 
where  there  is  (or  rather  was,  for  it  is  now 
blocked  up)  an  opening  in  the  west  wall  of 
the  north  aisle,  by  which  the  three  altars  in 
the  chancel  and  two  aisles  were  commanded 
by  a  person  outside  the  church,  though 
within  what  seems  to  have  been  a  little 
oratory  (now  entirely  removed)  dedicated 
to  S.  Tibald. 

Openings  sometimes  seem  to  command 
other  points,  and  may  then  be  well  enough 
called  "  Squints."  At  Hanniugton,  in 
Northamptonshire,  for  instance,  is  one 
which  seems  intended  to  enable  a  person 
in  the  porch  to  see  the  approach  of  the 
minister  from  Walgrave,  a  parish  generally 
united  under  the  same  incumbency  with 
Hannington. 

HALF  COMMUNION,  or  COMMU- 
NION IN  ONE  KIND  (See  Comm.union 
in  one  kind ;  Cup).  The  withholding  of 
the  cup  in  the  Eucharist  from  the  laity. 
This  is  the  practice  of  the  Church  of  Rome, 


376 


HALLELUJAH 


for  wHcli  no  primitive  authority  can  be 
found. 

HALLELUJAH  (See  Alleluia). 

HALLEL.  The  Hallel  are  the  six  psalms 
from  the  113th  to  the  118th,  deriving 
their  name  from  the  first  word  of  the  first 
psalm  in  the  series.  They  were  used  at 
the  principal  feasts  of  the  Jewish  Church- 
Passover,  Pentecost,  and  Tabernacles,  and 
also  at  the  later  feast  of  the  Dedication. 
The  Hallel  was  chanted  at  the  Paschal  feast 
of  each  household :  before  the  feast  as  far  as 
the  break  at  the  close  of  the  114th  Psalm  ; 
and  the  remainder  aftenvards,  while  the 
guests  were  partaking  of  the  fourth,  or  final 
cup.  There  is  little  doubt  that  our  Blessed 
Lord  and  His  disciples  sang  the  latter  part 
of  this  hymn  (Ps.  118)  in  concluding  the 
Lord's  Supper  ;  "  When  they  had  sung  an 
hymn."  "  The  proper  Psalms  for  the  Even- 
ing Service  on  Easter-day  are  the  two 
opening  and  the  last  Psalms  of  the  Hallel. 
They  formed,  as  it  seems,  the  closing  service 
of  praise  from  Scripture,  and  were  used  by 
our  Lord  before  He  suffered."— Blunt,  Theol. 
Diet.  301. 

HAMPTON  COURT  CONFERENCE. 
A  conference  appointed  by  James  I.  at 
Hampton  Court,  in  1603,  in  order  to  settle 
the  disputes  between  the  Church  and  the 
Puritans.  Nine  bishops,  and  as  many  dig- 
nitaries of  the  Church,  appeared  on  one  side, 
and  four  Puritan  ministers  on  the  other. 
It  lasted  for  three  days,  Jan.  14,  16,  and  18. 
On  the  third  day  the  king  became  so  en- 
raged with  the  Puritans  that  he  broke  up 
the  conference,  and  the  result  was  a  few 
slight  alterations  in  the  liturgy;  the  men- 
tion of  the  baptizing  of  infants  by  women, 
which  had  been  practised  in  our  Church  for 
many  hundred  years,  was  omitted,  but  not 
expressly  forbidden  (though  the  service  and 
rubrics  speak  only  of  the  "  priest") ;  "remis- 
sion of  sins"  was  inserted  in  the  rubric  of 
absolution ;  confirmation  termed  "  laying  on 
of  hands;"  all  the  thanksgivings,  except  the 
general  one,  were  inserted  in  the  Prayer 
Book;  to  the  catechism  was  annexed  the 
whole  of  the  latter  portion,  relative  to  the 
two  sacraments  ;  and  some  words  were 
altered  in  the  dominical  lessons,  with  a  view 
to  a  new  translation  of  the  sacred  volume. 
— Cardwell,  Conf.  pp.  217-225. 

HATCHMENT;  more  properly 
ACHIEVEMENT.  In  heraldry,  the  whole 
armorial  bearings  of  any  person  fully  em- 
blazoned, with  shield,  crest,  supporters, 
&c.  This  word  is  used  in  particular  for 
the  emblazonment  of  arms  hung  up  in 
churches,  in  memory  of  a  gentleman  of 
coat  armour,  or  one  of  any  higher  degree. 
There  was  formerly  much  of  religion  in 
heraldry ;  and  as  the  coat  was  assumed 
with  a  religious   feeling,  so  was  it  at  last 


HELL 

restored  to  the  sanctuary,  in  token  of  thank- 
ful acknowledgment  to  Almighty  God,  with 
whose  blessing  it  had  been  borne. 

HEALING,  OFFICE  OP.  This  was 
pubhshed  "  by  his  majesty's  command  "  in 
1686,  and  is  said  to  be  that  which  was  used 
in  the  time  of  Henry  VII.  The  office  is 
given  in  Maskell's  Monumenta,  vol.  iii. 
p.  386  (1882)  (See  King's  Evil;  Cramp 
Bings).     [H.] 

HEARSE,  or  HERSE.  French,  Aerse  ; 
radically  the  same  as  harrow;  Sw.  harf; 
Dan.  harve.  The  word  signifies  (L)  a  har- 
row; (ii.)  a  frame  for  lights  in  triangular 
shape,  like  a  harrow,  with  many  branches  or 
candlesticks ;  (iii.)  a  wooden  or  metal  frame 
to  support  the  pall  laid  over  a  bier  in  a 
church,  with  lights  upon  it.  There  are  good 
examples  at  Tanfield,  Hurstpierpont,  and 
the  Beauchamp  Chapel,  Warwick ;  (iv.)  a 
temporary  monument,  much  adorned  with 
images,  and  illuminated  with  tapers,  set  up 
in  churches,  and  left  sometimes  for  a  year ; 
(v.)  the  place  in  which  a  dead  corse  is 
deposited  (e.g.  "  King  Henry's  hearse " 
(Shakespeare,  Henry  VI.  Pt.  1) ;  (vi.)  a  horse- 
litter  for  the  dead ;  or  a  funeral  car  on  which 
the  body  is  laid.  Jeremy  Taylor  speaks 
of  strewing  the  herse  with  flowers.  At  the 
present  time  the  latter  is  the  meaning  to 
which  the  word  is  restricted. — Todd's  John- 
son ;  Walcott,  8ac.  Arch.  311.     [H.] 

HEATHEN.  Literally  "dwellers  on 
the  heath ; "  hence  inhabitants  of  wild  or 
remote  districts  who  were  the  last  to  he  con- 
verted. Compare  "  Pagan,"  from  paganus, 
a  villager.  See  Professor  Skeat's  Dictiormry, 
and  Archhp.  Trench's  St'udy  of  Words. 

HEAVEN.  Sax.  heafen,  hefen,  heofen, 
from  heafan,  to  heave.  An  elevated  or 
arched  place.  Among  Christians  it  implies 
that  place  where  God  affords  a  nearer  and 
more  immediate  view  of  himself,  and  a  more 
sensible  manifestation  of  his  glory,  than  in 
other  parts  of  the  universe.  It  is  spoken  of 
as  the  abode  of  angels  and  saints  (St. 
Matt,  xviii.  10 :  xxii.  30,  &c.).  That  it  is  a 
place  as  well  as  a  state,  is  clear  from  St.  John 
xiv.  2,  3,  and  from  the  existence  of  our 
Lord's  body  there.    [H.] 

HEBDOMAD ARIUS.  The  priest  whose 
weekly  turn  it  was  to  perform  the  divine 
offices  in  cathedrals  and  colleges.  In  some 
foreign  cathedrals  it  is  the  designation  of 
a  clergyman  corresponding  to  our  minor 
canons,  &c.  In  the  Scottish  universities 
the  name  was  given  to  one  of  the  superior 
members,  whose  weekly  turn  it  was  to  su- 
perintend the  discipline  of  the  students. 
The  office  was  effectively  exercised  at  St. 
Andrew's,  at  least,  till  of  late  years. 

HELL  (Anglo-Saxon  and  Icelandic,  hell, 
helle,  hela ;  Ger.  Bolle,  a  "  cavern ; "  "  con- 
cealed place ; "  a  "  mansion  of  the  dead  "). 


HELL 

I.  Three  entirely  diflerent  words  in  the 
original  language  of  the  New  Testament 
are  rendered  in  our  version  by  the  single 
word  "hell."  (1)  The  first  of  these  is 
Hades,  which  occurs  eleven  times  in  the 
New  Testament,  and  in  the  Authorised 
Version  is  in  every  case  but  one  translated 
"hell."  Now  Hades  is  never  used  to  de- 
note the  place  of  final  torment,  the  regions 
of  the  damned ;  but  signifies  "  the  place  of 
departed  spirite,"  whether  good  or  bad — 
the  place  where  they  are  kept  until  the 
day  of  judgment,  when  they  shall  be  re- 
united to  their  bodies,  and  go  each  to  his 
appointed  destiny.  (2)  Another  word, 
Gehenna,  signifies  the  place  of  torment, — 
the  eternal  abode  of  the  wicked.  At  the 
time  when  our  translation  was  made,  and 
the  Prayer  Book  compiled,  the  English 
word  "  hell "  had  a  more  extensive  meaning 
than  it  has  at  present.  It  originally  signi- 
fied to  cover  over  or  conceal,  and  it  is  still 
used  in.  this  sense  in  several  parts  of 
England,  where,  for  example,  to  cover  a 
church  or  a  house  with  a  roof  is  to  hell  the 
building,  and  the  person  by  whom  it  is 
done  is  called  a  Jiellier.  But  the  word  also 
denoted  the  place  of  future  misery,  and  is 
accordingly  used  in  that  sense  in  the  New 
Testament,  as  the  translation  of  Gehenna ; 
and  in  consequence  of  the  changes  which 
our  language  has  experienced  during  the 
last  two  hundred  years,  it  is  now  restricted 
to  this  particular  meaning  (See  Gehenna). 
(3)  St.  Peter  uses  another  word,  which  is 
also  translated  "  hell,"  in  the  passage,  "  If 
God  spared  not  the  angels  that  sinned,  but 
cast  them  down  to  hell,"  &c.  (2  St.  Peter, 
ii.  4).  Here  the  original  word  is  Tdprapos, 
which  imphes  the  lowest  degradation. 

II.  Bearing  in  mind  that  Hades  was 
translated  by  the  word  "  hell,"  for  want  of 
another  more  exactly  corresponding  with 
the  original,  it  will  readily  be  perceived  that 
the  article  in  the  Creed, "  He  descended  into 
hell,"  does  not  refer  to  the  place  of  final 
misery,  but  to  that  general  receptacle  of 
aU.  departed  human  souls,  both  penitent 
and  impenitent,  where  they  are  reserved  in 
a  state  of  comparative  enjoyment  or  misery, 
to  wait  the  morning  of  the  resurrection, 
when  their  bodies  being  united  to  their 
souls,  they  will  be  advanced  to  complete 
felicity  or  woe,  in  heaven  or  hell. 

It  was  necessary  that  our  Lord's  death 
should  be  attended  with  all  those  circum- 
stances which  mark  the  death  of  men. 
Christ  was  possessed  of  a  human  nature, 
both  body  and  soul,  beside  his  Divinity. 
The  body  of  man  at  death  sinks  to  the 
grave ;  and  the  soul  goes  to  Hades,  or  the 
place  of  departed  spirits.  In  like  manner 
the  body  of  our  Lord  was  laid  in  the  tomb, 
but  his  soul  went  to  the  general  repository 


HENOTICON 


377 


of  human  disembodied  spirits,  "  the  lower 
parts  of  the  earth "  (Ps.  xvi.  10 ;  Eph. 
iv.  9,  with  Ps.  Ixiii.  9,  and  Isa.  v.  14). 
Hades,  the  place  of  departed  souLs,  not 
Gehenna,  the  place  of  condemnation ; 
because  if  it  relate  to  the  place  of  either 
bUss  or  misery,  it  must  be  the  former,  in 
consistence  with  the  Lord's  promise  to  the 
penitent  thief  (St.  Luke  xxiii.  43).  Five 
diiferent  opinions  which  have  been  enter- 
tained with  regard  to  our  Lord's  descent 
into  hell  are  given  by  Bishop  Pearson  in 
his  work  on  the  Creed. 

The  sound  conclusion  as  to  the  whole, 
and  what  our  behef  might  be,  is,  perhaps, 
first,  as  to  fact,  that  the  soul  of  Christ, 
separated  from  his  body  by  death,  did  go 
into  the  common  place  of  departed  spirits, 
in  order  that  he  might  appear,  both  alive 
and  dead,  as  perfect  man.  All  that  was 
necessary  for  our  redemption,  by  way  of 
satisfaction,  was  effected  on  the  cross.  The 
exhibition  of  what  was  there  merited  was 
effected  by  his  resurrection ;  and  between 
these,  he  satisfied  the  law  of  death. 
Secondly,  as  to  the  effect.  As  the  grave  and 
hell  had  no  power  over  him,  the  "  head,"  so 
neither  shall  it  have  over  "  the  members." 
By  his  descent  he  freed  us  from  all  fear,  by 
his  resurrection  and  ascension  he  has  se- 
cured our  hope ;  and  thus  through  "  death, 
destroyed  him  that  hath  the  power  of  death, 
that  is,  the  devil." — Pearson  on  the  Creed, 
V.  251  (See  Bp.  Horsley,  Sermon  xx.).    [H.] 

HENOTICON  (eVdrTjf).  An  edict  pro- 
mulgated by  the  emperor  Zeno  in  the 
year  482,  with  the  intention  of  setthng 
the  manifold  dissensions  which  were  then 
troubling  Church  and  State.  In  it  the 
Creed  of  the  Nicene  and  Constantinopolitan 
Councils  was  recognised  as  the  only  one 
allowed  by  the  Church ;  and  the  Nestorians 
and  Eutychians  were  pronounced  heretics. 
Christ  Jesus  was  declared  to  possess  two 
natures,  in  one  of  which  He  was  ojioovcrios, 
of  one  substance  with  the  Father ;  and  in 
the  other  ofwoimos  with  us.  Thus  the 
doctrines  of  the  Council  of  Chalcedon  were 
fuUy  recognised,  although  no  reference  is 
made  to  it.  This  formula  of  union  was 
calculated  to  unite  the  more  considerate  of 
both  parties,  and  in  Egypt  the  "  Henoticon  " 
was  extensively  embraced.  But  the  bishops 
of  Rome  were  opposed  to  it,  and  were  able 
to  render  it  generally  inefficient.  It  was 
composed  by  Acacius,  patriarch  of  Constan- 
tinople, and  was  addressed  to  the  bishops 
and  faithful  in  Alexandria,  Libya,  Egypt, 
and  Pentapolis.  But  it  was  only  the 
expression  of  individual  opinion,  and  had 
not  the  sanction  of  a  general  council. — 
Evagrius,  Hist.  Eccl.  iii.  14;  Gibbon, 
Decline  and  Fall,  o.  xlvii. ;  Diet.  Christ. 
Biog.  s.  V.     [H.] 


378 


HEEESIAECH 


HERESIAECH.     A  leader  in  heresy. 

HEEESY.^This  word  is  derived  from 
the  Greek,  alpecris,  a  choice,  and  it  means 
an  arbitrary  adoption,  in  matters  of  faith,  of 
opinions  at  variance  with  the  doctrines 
deUvered  by  Christ  and  the  Apostles,  and 
received  by  the  Cathohc  Church.  At  the 
same  time  we  may  remark,  that  it  is  gene- 
rally agreed  that  the  opinion  must  be  per- 
tinaciously and  obstinately  held,  in  order 
to  constitute  formal  heresy.  And  if  there 
be  a  legitimate  doubt  in  a  controversy 
which  of  two  contrary  doctrines  is  stated  in 
Scripture  and  received  by  the  Church, 
either  may  be  held  without  heresy.  It  is 
obvious,  also,  that  mere  ignorance,  or  a 
temporary  error  in  ignorance,  is  altogether 
different  from  heresy. 

I.  Heresies  began  very  early  in  the 
Christian  Church.  Eusebius  fixes  the  be- 
ginniag  of  most  of  them  to  the  reign  of  the 
emperor  Hadrian.  And  yet  it  is  certaiu 
that  Simon  Magus  had  pubhshed  his  errors 
before  that  time,  and  set  up  a  sect,  which 
gave  rise  to  most  of  the  ancient  heresies. 

The  laws,  both  of  the  Church  and  State, 
were  very  severe  against  those  who  were 
adjudged  to  be  heretics.  Those  of  the 
State,  made  by  the  Christian  emperors  from 
the  time  of  Constantine,  are  comprised 
under  one  title.  Be  Smreticis,  in  the 
Theodosian  Code.  The  principal  of  them 
are,  (1)  The  general  note  of  infamy  affixed 
to  all  heretics  in  common.  (2)  All  com- 
merce forbidden  to  be  held  with  them.  (3) 
The  depriving  them  of  all  offices  of  profit 
and  dignity.  (4)  The  disqualifying  them 
to  dispose  of  their  estates  by  will,  or  receive 
estates  from  others.  (5)  The  imposing  on 
them  pecuniary  mulcts.  (6)  The  pro- 
scribing and  banishing  them.  (7)  The  in- 
flicting corporal  punishment  on  them,  such 
as  scourging,  &c.,  before  banishment.  Be- 
sides these  laws,  which  chiefly  affected  the 
persons  of  heretics,  there  were  several  others, 
which  tended  to  the  extirpation  of  heresy, 
such  as,  (1)  Those  which  forbade  heretical 
teachers  to  propagate  their  doctrines  publicly 
or  privately.  (2)  Those  which  forbade 
heretics  to  hold  pubhc  disputations.  (3) 
Such  laws  as  prohibited  all  heretical 
meetings  and  assemblies.  (4)  Those  which 
denied  to  the  children  of  heretical  parents 
their  patrimony  and  inheritance,  unless 
they  returned  to  the  Church.  And  (5)  Such 
laws  as  ordered  the  books  of  heretics  to  be 
burned.  There  were  many  other  penal 
laws  made  against  heretics,  from  the  time 
of  Constantine  to  Theodosius  junior  and 
Valentinian  III.  But  the  few  already 
mentioned  may  be  sufiicient  to  give  an  idea 
of  the  rigour  with  which  the  empire  treated 
such  persons  as  held,  or  taught,  opinions 
contrary  to  the  faith  of  the  Catholic  Church, 


HERESY 

wnose  discipline  towards  heretics  was  no- 
less  severe  than  the  civil  laws. 

For,  (1)  The  Church  was  accustomed  to 
pronounce  a  foi'mal  anathema  or  excommu- 
nication against  them.  Thus  the  Council 
of  Nice  ends  her  creed  with  an  anathema 
against  all  those  who  opposed  the  doctrine 
there  delivered.  And  there  are  innumer- 
able instances  of  this  kind  to  be  found  in 
the  volumes  of  the  Councils.  (2)  Some 
canons  debarred  them  from  the  very  lowest 
privileges  of  Church  communion,  forbidding 
them  to  enter  into  the  church,  so  much  as 
to  hear  the  sermon,  or  the  Scriptures  read 
in  the  service  of  the  catechumens.  But 
this  was  no  general  rule,  for  liberty  was 
often  granted  to  heretics  to  be  present  at 
the  sermons,  in  hopes  of  their  conversion ; 
and  the  historians  tell  us  that  Chrysostom 
by  this  means  brought  over  many  to  ac- 
knowledge the  Divinity  of  Christ,  whilst 
they  had  liberty  to  come  and  hear  his 
sermons.  (3)  The  Church  prohibited  all 
persons,  under  pain  of  excommunication,  ta 
join  with  heretics  in  any  religious  offices. 
(4)  By  the  laws  of  the  Church,  no  one  was 
to  eat,  or  converse  familiarly  with  heretics, 
or  to  read  their  writings,  or  to  contract  any 
affinity  with  them :  their  names  were  to  be 
be  struck  out  of  the  Diptychs,  or  sacred 
registers  of  the  Church ;  and,  if  they  died 
in  heresy,  no  psalmody,  or  other  solemnity,, 
was  to  be  used  at  their  funeral.  (5)  The 
testimonj""  of  heretics  was  not  to  be  taken, 
in  any  ecclesiastical  cause  whatever.  These 
are  the  chief  ecclesiastical  laws  against 
heretics. 

As  to  the  terms  of  penance  imposed  upon 
relenting  heretics,  or  such  as  were  willing 
to  renounce  their  errors,  and  be  reconciled 
to  the  Church,  they  were  various,  and 
differed  according  to  the  canons  of  different 
councils,  or  the  usages  of  different  Churches. 
The  Council  of  Eliberis  (soon  after  a.d.  300) 
appoints  ten  years'  penance,  before  repenting 
heretics  are  admitted  to  communion.  The 
Council  of  Agde  (a.d.  506)  contracted  this 
term  into  that  of  three  years.  The  Council 
of  Epone  (a.d.  517)  reduced  it  to  two  years 
only. 

The  ancient  Christian  Church  made  a 
distinction  between  such  heretics  as  contu- 
maciously resisted  the  admonitions  of  the 
Church,  and  such  as  never  had  any  ad- 
monition given  them,  for  none  were  reputed 
formal  heretics,  or  treated  as  such,  till  the 
Church  had  given  them  a  first  and  second 
admonition,  according  to  the  Apostles'  rule. 

The  principal  sects  of  heretics,  which 
disturbed  the  peace  of  the  Church,  sprung 
up  in  the  first  six  centuries :  most  of  ihe 
heresies,  in  after  ages,  being  nothing  but 
the  old  ones  new  vamped,  or  revived.  The 
following    table    may   serve    to   give   the- 


HERESY 

reader  a  compendious  view  of  the  most 
remarkable  of  the  ancient  heresies.  Fuller 
accounts  are  given  under  the  different 
headings. 

CENTUKT  I. 

1.  The  Simonians,  or  followers  of  Simon 
Magus.  2.  Cerinthians  and  Ebionites,  fol- 
lowers of  Cerinthus  and  Bbion.  3.  The 
Nicolaites,  followers  of  Nicolas,  deacon  of 
Antioch. 

CENTUKY   II. 

4.  The  Basilidians,  followers  of  Basilides 
of  Alexandria.  5.  The  Carpocratians,  fol- 
lowers of  Carpocrates  of  Alexandria.  6.  The 
Valentinians,  followers  of  Valentinus.  7. 
The  Gnostics ;  so  called  from  their  pretences 
to  superior  knowledge  (yvaa-is).  8.  The  Naza- 
renes ;  who  ingrafted  the  law  of  Moses  on 
Christianity,  &c.  9.  The  Millenarians  or 
Ghiliasts ;  so  called  because  they  expected 
to  reign  with  Christ  a  thousand  years  upon 
the  earth.  10.  The  Cainites ;  a  branch 
of  the  Valentinians.  11.  The  Sethians ; 
who  held  that  Seth,  the  son  of  Adam,  was 
the  Messiah.  12.  The  Quartodecimans ; 
who  observed  Easter  on  the  fourteenth  day 
of  the  first  month,  in  conformity  to  the 
Jewish  custom   of  keeping   the   Passover. 

13.  The   Cerdonians,  followers  of  Cerdon. 

14.  The  Marcionites,  followers  of  Marcion. 

15.  The    Cataphrygians,     or    Montanists. 

16.  The  Encratites,  or  Tatianists,  followers 
of  Tatian.  17.  The  Alogians;  so  called 
because  they  denied  the  Divinity  of  the 
Word.  18.  The  Artotyrites ;  so  called,  be- 
cause they  offered  bread  and  cheese  in  the 
Eucharist  (aprot,  rvpos).  19.  The  Angelics  ; 
so  called,  because  they  worshipped  angels. 

CENTURY  m. 

20.  The  Monarchici,  or  Patripassians, 
followers  of  Praxeas.  21.  The  Ardbici. 
22.  The  Aquarians  ;  who  used  only  water  in 
the  Eucharist.  25.  The  Novatians.  24.  The 
Origenists,  followers  of  Origen.  25.  The 
Melchisedechians ;  who  held  Melchisedech 
to  be  the  Messiah.  26.  The  Sabellians, 
followers  of  Sabellius.  27.  The  Maniclimans, 
followers  of  Manes. 

CENTUKY   IV. 

28.  The  Arians,  followers  of  Arius.  29. 
The  Colluthians,  followers  of  Colluthus. 
30.  The  Macedonians ;  who  denied  the 
Divinity  of  the  Holy  Ghost.  31.  The 
Agnoetse ;  who  denied  the  certainty  of  the 
Divine  prescience.  32.  The  Apollinarians, 
followrs  of  Apollinaris.  53.  The  Timo- 
theans ;  who  held  that  our  Saviour  was 
incarnate  only  for  the  benefit  and  advan- 
tage of  our  bodies.  34.  The  CoUyridians  ; 
so  called,  because  they  made  a  kind  of  god- 
dess of  the  Blessed  Virgin,  and  offered  cakes 


HEEESY 


37& 


to  her.  35.  The  Seleucians,  followers  of  Se- 
Icucus.  36.  The  Priscillianists,  followers 
of  Prisoillian,  a  Spanish  bishop.  37.  The 
Anthropomorphites ;  so  called,  because  they 
ascribed  a  body  to  God.  38.  The  Jovinia- 
nists,  followers  of  Jovinian ;  who  denied  the 
virginity  of  Mary.  39.  The  Messalians ; 
who  chiefly  pretended  to  prophecy.  40.  The 
Bonosians,  followers  of  Bonosus. 

CENTUEY  v. 

41.  The  Pelagians,  followers  of  Pelagius. 
42.  Nestorians,  followers  of  Nestorius.  43. 
The  Ewtychians,  followers  of  Eutyches. 
44.  The  Theopaschites,,  followers  of  Petrus 
Fullo,  bishop  of  Antioch. 

CENTDEY   VI. 

45.  The  Predesiinarians ;  so  called,  be- 
cause they  held  that  the  salvation  or  damna- 
tion of  men  is  pre-ordained,  and  that  no 
man  is  saved  or  damned  by  his  works. 
46.  The  AplitJiartodocetes,  or  Incorrupt- 
ihilists;  so  called,  because  they  held  that 
our  Saviour's  body  was  incorruptible,  and 
exempt  from  passion.  47.  A  second  sec*; 
of  Agnoetie ;  so  called,  because  they  held 
that  our  Blessed  Saviour,  when  upon  earth,, 
did  not  know  the  day  of  judgment.  48.  The 
Monotheletes ;  who  held  that  there  was  but 
one  will  in  Jesus  Christ. 

These  were  the  principal  sects  of  here- 
tics, which,  in  those  early  ages,  infested 
the  Christian  Church.  The  succeeding 
ages  produced  a  great  variety  of  heretics 
likewise ;  as  the  Onosimnchi  and  Lampe- 
tians,  in  the  seventh  century  ;  the  Agony- 
elites  in  the  eighth;  the  Perengarians, 
Simoniacs,  and  Vecilians,  in  the  eleventh ; 
the  Bogomiles,  in  the  twelfth ;  the  Fratri- 
celli  and  Beguards,  in  the  thirteenth ;  tO' 
enumerate  all  which  would  require  too  much 
space. — Broughton,  Bihliotheca,  vol.  i. ;  Diet. 
CJirist.  Ant.  766. 

II.  In  England  the  laws  against  heresy 
have  been  very  strict.  By  the  common  law 
of  the  Church  any  bishop  was  empowered 
to  punish  heresy  canonically  {Consiit.. 
Arundel,  A.D.  1408 ;  Gibson's  Codex,  tit. 
xvi.  c.  2).  By  the  statute  law,  bishops 
were  ordered  to  certify  to  the  Lord  High 
Chancellor  the  preachersof  heretical  doctrines,, 
and  arrest  and  imprisonment  was  the  pun- 
ishment (5  Rich.  II.  c.  5.).  The  most  terrible 
statute  of  aU  ("  de  Haeretico  Comburendo  ") 
was  passed  in  1400  (2  Hen.  IV.  c.  15). 
This  Act  was  repealed  by  25  Hen.  VIII. 
c.  14,  though  obstinate  heretics  were  still 
to  be  "  committed  by  the  king's  writ  to  the 
lay  power,  to  bo  burned  in  open  places." 
The  Act  31  Hen.  VIII.  c.  14  for  abol- 
ishing diversity  of  opinion  in  matters  of 
religion,  adjudged  that  all  who  inpugned  the 
doctrine  of  transubstantiation    should    be 


380 


HERESY 


deemed  heretics  and  "  suffer  execution  by 
way  of  buming."  Four  years  later  it  was 
enacted  that  any  indictment  for  heresy 
must  be  by  oath  of  twelve  men  (35 
Hen.  Vni.  c.  5). 

In  the  first  year  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  an 
Act  of  Parliament  was  passed  to  enable 
persons  to  try  heretics,  and  the  following 
directions  were  given  for  their  guidance : — 
"  And  such  persons  to  whom  the  queen 
shall  by  letters  patent  under  the  great 
seal  give  authority  to  ■  execute  any  juris- 
diction spiritual,  shall  not  in  anywise  have 
power  to  adjudge  any  matter  or  cause  to 
!be  heresy,  but  only  such  as  heretofore 
have  been  adjudged  to  be  heresy  by  the 
authority  of  the  canonical  Scriptures,  or 
hj  some  of  the  first  four  general  councils, 
or  by  any  other  general  council  wherein 
the  same  was  declared  heresy  by  the  ex- 
press and  plain  words  of  the  said  canoni- 
cal Scriptures,  or  such  as  hereafter  shall 
be  judged  or  determined  to  be  heresy  by 
the  high  court  of  parhament,  with  the  as- 
sent of  the  clergy  in  their  convocation." 

The  last  writs  "de  Hseretico  Combu- 
rendo"  were  issued  in  the  ninth  year  of 
James  I.'s  reign,  when  Legate  was  burned 
for  Arianism,  and  Neile  for  holding  the 
heresies  of  Ebion,  Cerinthus,  Arius,  &c., 
"  which  he  obstinately  held  and  main- 
tained" (Gibson's  Cod.,  f.  353).  The 
Brief  "de  hairetico  "  was  finally  annulled  by 
the  Act  29  Car.  II.  c.  9.  There  were  other 
Acts  against  heresy,  as  for  instance,  that  of 
2  Hen.  V.  c.  7,  which  ordered  the  lands 
and  goods  of  any  convicted  Lollard  (see 
Lollards')  to  be  escheated  (^Constit.  Arund., 
A.D.  1408).  This  Act  was  repealed  by 
1  Edw.  VI.  c.  12,  revived  in  Queen  Mary's 
reign,  and  finally  annulled  by  1  Eliz.  c.  1. 

The  Act  5  &  6  Edw.  VI.  c.  13  made  it  a 
part  of  the  vow  of  bishops  and  priests  that  they 
will  "  banish  and  drive  away  aU  erroneous 
and  strange  doctrines,  contrary  to  God's 
word ; "  and  reference  has  been  made  to  the 
Act  in  the  first  year  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  by 
which  heresy  was  to  be  judged  "  by  the 
authority  of  Holy  Scriptures,  or  by  some  of 
the  first  four  general  councils,  or  by  Parlia- 
ment with  the  assent  of  convocation."  But 
the  only  practical  or  legal  meaning  of  heresy 
now  is  the  teaching  of  doctrines  contrary  to 
the  Prayer  Book  or  the  Articles,  for  which 
deprivation  is  the  punishment,  unless  the 
heresy  is  retracted,  under  the  Act  13  Eliz. 
c.  12,  under  which  Mr.  Heath  and  Mr. 
Voysey  were  deprived  by  the  two  provin- 
cial judges,  and  their  decisions  affirmed  by 
the  Privy  Council  in  quite  recent  times. 
It  would  be  impossible  to  state  what  is 
heresy,  under  the  legal  term.  As  an  eccle- 
siastical offence  heresy  has  died  away,  and 
is  not  even   mentioned  in   modern  books. 


HERMENEUT.S; 

In  a  case — Regina  v.  Stone — Lord  Stowell, 
quoting  the  above  Act,  which  makes  it 
an  offence  to  affirm  any  doctrine  contrary 
to  the  39  Articles,  gave  judgment  against 
Stone,  but  stated  that,  as  temporal  judge, 
he  had  no  power  to  inflict  sentence  of  de- 
privation. The  Bishop  of  London  there- 
fore attended  the  court  for  the  purpose 
(Hagg.  Gons.  424;  Cripps,  JScdes.  Law,  p. 
585,  Ed.  1845).  But  all  that  is  gone,  and  the 
Dean  of  Arches  can  deprive,  as  was  decided 
in  Bonwell's  case.  In  ecclesiastical  courts 
of  late  years  trials  have  been  held  rather  in 
respect  of  the  legitimacy  of  certain  vest- 
ments, than  with  regard  to  heresy,  and 
though  in  the  case  of  those  who  hold  office  in 
the  Church  the  law  may  be  invoked,  there 
may  be  in  every  other  case  entire  fireedom. 

There  are  at  the  present  time  more  than 
170  sects,  more  or  less  antagonistic  to 
the  Church  of  England  (see  Sects). — ^Philli- 
more's  Ecc.  Law ;  Palmer's  Treatise,  i.  14 ; 
Blunt's  Theol.  Diet.  306 ;  Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  iii.  191,  376.     [H.] 

HERETIC.  Dr.  Johnson,  in  his  dic- 
tionary, defines  a  heretic  to  be,  "  one  who 
propagates  his  private  opinions  in  oppo- 
sition to  the  Catholic  Church ; ''  and  the 
Catholic  or  universal  Church,  in  the  second 
general  council,  has  pronounced  those  to 
be  heretics  "who,  while  they  pretend  to 
confess  the  sound  faith,  have  separated  and 
held  meetings  contrary  to  our  canonical 
bishops."' — Cone.  Const.  Can.  6. 

A  man  may  be  erroneous  in  doctrine 
and  yet  not  a  heretic ;  for  heresy  is  a  per- 
tinacious adherence  to  an  opinion  when  it 
is  known  that  the  Church  has  condemned 
it  (See  the  preceding  article). 

Although  the  Scripture  only  is  our  guide, 
there  are  certain  points  of  disputable  doc- 
trine on  which  the  Church  Universal  has 
decided,  e.g.  the  doctrine  of  the  Trinity; 
and  he  who  refuses  "  to  hear  the  Church  " 
on  these  points,  is  held  a  heretic  by 
the  Church  Universal.  There  are  certain 
points  on  which  our  own  Church  has  de- 
cided, e.g.  the  doctrine  of  transubstan- 
tiation,  and  he  who  holds  this  doctrine  is 
regarded  as  a  heretic  by  the  Church  of 
England. 

HBRMENEUT^  (From  ^p/iijvevo),  to 
interpret).  Persons  in  the  ancient  Church, 
mentioned  by  Epiphanius  (Expos.  Fidei.  n. 
21),  whose  business  it  was  to  render  one  lan- 
guage into  another,  as  there  was  occasion, 
both  in  reading  the  Scriptures,  and  in  tho 
homilies  that  were  made  to  the  people  ; 
an  office  which  was  very  important  in  those 
Churches  where  the  people  spoke  difierent 
languages,  as  in  Palestine,  where  somo 
spoke  Syriac,  others  Greek ;  and  in  Africa, 
where  some  spoke  the  Latin,  and  othci'.s 
the  Punic  tongue. 


HEEMEKEUTICS 

_  HEBMENEUTICS  (From  Ipixqvda,  to 
interpret).  The  science  of  interpretation 
of  the  sacred  Scriptures.  It  differs  from 
exegesis  inasmuch  as  its  province  is  to 
discover  the  real  meaning  of  the  words  and 
idioms  of  the  text,  while  the  latter  implies 
the  exposition  of  this  meaning. 

HERMIT  or  EREMITE  {lpr„xlTr,s),  lit.  an 
inhabitant  of  the  desert — 6  ev  ipr]iia  6m- 
yav  (Suidas,  s.  v.).  The  word  includes  all 
dwellers  in  the  desert,  who  lived,  some  in 
communities,  some  in  individual  seclusion : 
but  it  is  commonly  used  to  imply  one  who 
lived  a  solitary  life,  generally  in  a  cave  or 
rude  hut  of  his  own  construction,  and  prac- 
tised the  greatest  austerities. — ^Evagi-.  H.  E. 
i.  21 ;  Soz.  vi.  29,  34 ;  Aug.  de  Mor.  Ecdes. 
c.  31 ;  Pleury  (Newman's  Ed.),  xx.  5  (See 
Monks ;  Coenobites  ;  Anchorets).     [H.] 

^  HERMITAGES,  calledbySt  Chrysostom 
olKiaKoi  KpavyrjS  aiTT]XKayop.€voi,,  were  cells 
constructed  in  private  and  solitary  places 
for  single  persons,  or  for  small  commu- 
nities, and  were  sometimes  annexed  to  larger 
religious  houses. 

HETERODOX  (Gk.  iripos,  and  b6^a— 
opposed  to  orthodox,  vp66s  and  6d^a,  right 
opinion).  Contrary  to  the  faith  or  doctrine 
established  in  the  true  Church. 

HEXAPLA.  A  book  containing  the 
Hebrew  text  of  the  Bible  written  in  He- 
brew and  Greek  characters,  with  the  trans- 
lations of  the  Septuagiut,  of  Aquila,  Theo- 
dotion,  and  Symmachus,  in  six  several 
columns.  There  was  added  to  it  a  fifth 
translation,  found  at  Jericho,  without  the 
author's  name ;  and  a  sixth,  named  Nico- 
politanum,  because  found  at  Nicopolis: 
Origen  joined  to  it  a  translation  of  the 
Psalms,  but  still  the  book  retained  the  name 
of  Eexapla,  because  the  fifth  and  six  trans- 
lations did  not  extend  to  the  whole  Bible; 
and  so  the  same  book  of  Origen  had  but  six 
columns  in  divers  places,  eight  in  some,  and 
nine  in  the  Psalms.  Others  are  of  opinion 
that  the  two  columns  of  the  Hebrew  text 
were  not  reckoned ;  and  that  the  translation 
of  the  Psalms  was  not  to  be  considered  so 
as  to  give  a  new  name  to  the  book.  When 
the  edition  contained  only  the  translations 
of  the  Septuagint,  Aquila,  Theodotion,  and 
Symmachus,  it  was  called  Tetrapla,  and  the 
name  of  Obtapla  was  sometimes  given  to 
the  eight  versions,  that  is,  to  the  collections 
containing  the  translations  of  Jericho  and 
Nicopolis.  RufiBnus,  speaking  of  this  ela- 
borate work,  affirms  that  Origen  undertook 
it  because  of  the  continual  controversies 
between  the  Jews  and  Christians :  the  Jews 
citing  the  Hebrew,  and  the  Christians  the 
Septuagint,  in  their  disputes,  this  father 
was  willing  to  let  the  Christians  understand 
how  the  Jews  read  the  Bible ;  and  to  this 
end  he   laid  the  versions  of  Aquila,  and 


HISTORIANS 


381 


some  other  Greek  translations,  before  them, 
which  had  been  made  from  the  Hebrew ; 
but  few  people  being  able  to  buy  so  great  a 
work,  Origen  undertook  to  abridge  it,  and 
for  that  purpose  published  a  version  of  the 
Septuagint,  to  which  he  added  some  supple- 
ments, taken  out  of  Theodotion's  trans- 
lation, in  the  places  where  the  Septuagint 
had  not  rendered  the  Hebrew  text ;  and 
which  supplements  were  marked  with  an 
asterisk.  He  added  also  a  small  line  like  a 
spit,  where  the  Septuagint  had  something 
that  was  not  in  the  Hebrew  text.  The  loss 
of  the  Hexapla  is  one  of  the  greatest  which 
the  Church  has  sustained.  But  a  few  frag- 
ments remain,  published  by  Montfaucon,  in 
1713 ;  and  by  Bahrdt  (an  abridgment,  and 
not  a  very  skilful  one,  of  the  former,)  in 
1769.  Dr.  Field,  whose  work  was  published 
in  1875,  has  not  only  revised  Montfaucon's 
work,  but  added  the  result  of  further 
researches  (See  Diet.  Glirist.  Bioq.). 

HIERARCHY  (See  Bishops).  A 
designation  equally  applied  to  the  ranks  of 
celestial  beings  in  the  Jerusalem  above,  and 
to  the  apostolic  order  of  the  ministry  in  the 
Church  below.  In  reference  to  the  latter, 
it  is  an  error  to  suppose  that  it  necessarily 
implies  temporal  distinction,  wealth,  splen- 
dour, or  any  other  adjuncts  with  which  the 
ministry  may,  in  certain  times  and  countries, 
have  been  distinguished.  These  are  mere 
accidents,  which  prejudice  has  identified 
with  the  being  of  a  hierarchy,  but  from 
which  no  just  inference  can  be  drawn 
against  the  inherent  spiritual  dignity  of  the 
Christian  priesthood. 

HIGH  PRIEST.  The  highest  person  in 
the  divinely  appointed  ecclesiastical  polity 
of  the  Jews.  To  him  in  the  Christian 
Church  answers  the  bishop,  the  presbyter 
answering  to  the  priest,  and  the  deacon  tO' 
the  Levite. 

HISTORIANS,  ECCLESIASTICAL. 
Those  writers  who  record  the  acts  and 
monuments  of  the  Christian  Church.  After 
the  evangelical  historians,  the  most  dis- 
tinguished is  Hegesippus,  who  lived  princi- 
pally in  the  reign  of  Marcus  Aurelius  (a.d. 
161-180).  He  wi-otc  five  books  of  eccle- 
siastical history,  called  Commentaries  of  the 
Acts  of  the  Church,  wherein  he  described 
the  character  of  the  holy  Apostles,  their 
missions,  &c.,  the  remarkable  events  iu  the 
Church,  and  the  several  heresies,  schisms, 
and  persecutions  which  had  afflicted  it  from 
our  Lord's  death  to  the  writer's  own  times. 
All  the  writings  of  Hegesippus  are  now  lost 
except  a  few  fragments.  Next  follows 
Eusebius,  bishop  of  Csesarea,  about  a.d.  315 
to  339,  a  pupil  of  Pamphilus,  on  which 
account  he  is  often  called  Eusebius  Pamphili. 
He  wrote  an  ecclesiastical  history  in  ten 
books,  comprising  a  history  of  the  Church 


382 


HILARY 


from  our  Lord's  birth  to  the  conversion  of 
Constantine  the-  Great,  which  he  compiled 
chiefly  from  the  commentary  of  Hegesippus. 
■St.  Jerome  and  Nicephorus  derive  the 
materials  of  their  history  from  Busehius. 
The  histories  written  by  Socrates,  Theo- 
doret,  and  Sozomen,  relate  to  their  own 
times  only :  4  th  and  5th  centuries.  These 
are  the  sources  from  which  all  modern 
historians  of  the  early  Church  derive  their 
materials.  Excellent  translations  of  the 
early  Church  historians  have  lately  been 
published  by  Messrs.  Clark,  Edinburgh. 

HILARY,  Bishop  and  Confessor.  Com- 
memorated in  the  English  Calendar  on 
Januaiy  13.  He  was  appointed  bishop  of 
Poitiers,  the  place  of  his  birth,  about  a.d. 
354.  A  strong  upholder  of  the  orthodox 
faith  against  the  Arian  heresy,  he  was 
banished  by  the  emperor  Constantius  for 
Ms  defence  of  St.  Athanasius.  In  the  East 
he  boldly  defended  the  doctrine  of  the 
Trinity  at  the  Council  of  Seleucia,  in  Isau- 
ria,  A.D.  359.  Afterwards  he  returned  to 
Gaul,  and  convened  several  councils  for  the 
condemnation  of  the  Arian  bishops.  He 
died  A.D.  367.  To  him  has  been  sometimes 
assigned  the  composition  of  the  "  Te  Deum  " ; 
but  that  honour  is  also  given  to  his  name- 
sate  Hilary  of  Aries,  a.d.  440,  or  (more  com- 
monly) to  St.  Ambrose  (See  Te  Deum). 

Hilary  Term  in  the  Courts  of  Law  used 
to  begin  on  this  festival:  but  now  begins 
January  11,  and  lasts  till  January  31.  [H.] 
HOLY  CROSS  DAY.  Observed  in  the 
calendar  on  September  14.  It  commemo- 
rates the  exhibition  of  the  True  Cross  in 
the  Basilica  built  by  the  empress  Helena  at 
Jerusalem  in  326  (See  Invention  of  the 
Cross).     [H.] 

HOLY  COMMUNION.  L  This  is  one 
of  the  names  given  to  the  Lord's  Supper, 
and  is  due  to  St.  Paul's  language  in  his 
First  Epistle  to  the  Corinthians.  "  The  cup 
of  blessing,"  he  writes,  "  which  we  bless,  is 
it  not  a  communion  (^Kowavia)  of  the  blood 
of  Christ  ?  The  bread  which  we  break,  is 
it  not  a  communion  of  the  body  of  Christ  ?  " 
<1  Cor.  X.  16).  "He  does  not  indeed," 
remarks  Waterland,  "directly  call  the 
Sacrament  by  this  name,  as  others  have 
done  since ;  he  was  signifying  what  the 
thing  is,  or  what  it  does,  rather  than  how 
it  was  then  called"  (Waterland,  M^orhs,  iv. 
473).  But  undoubtedly  his  account  gave 
the  first  occasion  for  the  name,  and  from 
him  it  found  its  way  into  use  in  the  Church. 
In  the  earlier  centuries  it  does  not  occur 
except  in  the  somewhat  doubtful  Ajiostolical 
Canons,  but  we  find  the  word  communio 
in  the  time  of  Cyprian,  i.e.  about  the  middle 
of  the  third  century.  In  the  following  age, 
it  became  very  common,  both  in  the  Greek 
and  Latin  Fathers.    Thus  Hilary,  about  the 


HOLY  COMMUNION 

middle  of  the  fourth  century,  styles  the- 
Lord's  Supper  the  "  Communion  of  the  Holy  ; 
Body,"  or  the  "Sacrament  of  the  Holy  j 
Communion,"  or  the  "  Communion  of  the  ; 
Everlasting  Sacraments."  Basil  and  Chryso- 
stom  have  sometimes  the  single  word 
"Communion"  to  denote  the  Eucharist, 
sometimes  the  "Communion  of  the  (Jood 
Thing,"  or  of  "  the  Mysteries  "  (iSasil,  Epist. 
Can.  prima  ad  Amphiloch,  p.  273  ;  Chryso- 
stom,  Horn.  x.  in  Johannem).  The  Latin 
term  is  Communio,  or  Communicatio,  or  Par- 
ticipatio,  and  the  meaning  of  the  word  may 
be  reduced  under  three  heads :  (1)  In  refer- 
ence to  the  communion  we  therein  enjoy 
with  Christ  and  with  each  other;  (2)  in 
reference  to  the  religious  banquet  of  which 
we  partake  in  common  with  our  fellow 
Christians;  (3)  in  reference  to  our  being 
therein  made  partners  of  Christ's  kingdom. 
II.  Tfie  earliest  account  of  tlie  Holy  Com- 
mAinion. — The  earliest  description  of  the 
Holy  Commimion  is  to  be  found  in  Justin 
Martyr's  account  of  the  celebration  of  the 
Eucharist  for  the  newly  baptized.  This 
portion  of  the  series  is  described  as  follows 
{Apol.  i.  65,  66):  "Having  ended  the 
prayers,  we  salute  one  another  with  a  kiss. 
Then  is  presented  to  the  brother  who  presides 
bread  and  a  cup  of  wine  mixed  with  water 
((tpa/iOToi),  and  he,  receiving  them,  sends 
up  praise  and  glory  to  the  Father  of  all, 
through  the  name  of  the  Son  and  of  the 
Holy  Ghost,  and  offers  a  thanksgiving 
(evxapi-aria)  for  that  He  hath  vouchsafed 
to  us  these  blessings.  And  when  he  has 
finished  the  prayers  and  the  thanksgivings, 
all  the  people  present  respond  by  saying 
Amen.  .  ,  .  And  when  the  president  has 
given  thanks,  and  all  the  people  have  re- 
sponded, those  who  are  called  among  us 
deacons  give  to  each  of  those  who  are  present 
to  partake  of  the  bread  and  wiue  mixed  with 
water,  over  which  thanks  have  been  given, 
and  carry  a  portion  to  those  not  present,  to 
them  alone."  It  is  to  be  observed  that  no 
account  is  here  given  of  the  posture  or 
gesture  either  of  the  ministrant  or  recipient, 
nor  are  we  told  anything  as  regards  the 
precise  words  used  at  the  administration. 
All  that  Justin  tells  us  is  that  after  the 
'Evxapia-Tia,  those  whom  "  we  call  deacons 
give  to  each  of  those  present  to  partake  of  the 
bread  and  of  the  wine  mixed  with  water, 
over  which  thanks  have  been,  and  carry  away 
to  those  who  are  not  present." 

III.  WJio  communicated  ? — Justin  helps  us 
to  answer  this  question.  He  expressly  tells 
us  that  the  deacon  gave  "  to  each  of  those 
present."  We  find  the  same  in  aU  the  early 
accounts  of  Holy  Communion.  Thus  Ter- 
tuUian  states  that  in  the  Airican  Church  of 
the  second  century,  "  the  Eucharist  was  ad- 
ministered  to  all  who  were  present"  (i>e 


HOLY  COJIMUNION 

Orationc,  c.  14),  and  similarly  Cyprian  (i)e 
Lapsis,  c.  25)  speaks  of  the  deacoa  as  pre- 
seuting  the  cup,  and  says  "  this  food  is  called 
among   us    Eixapiaria,    tjie  Eucharist,"  of 
which  no  one  is  allowed  to  partake  except 
one  who  believes  that  the  things  taught  hy 
us  are  true,  and  who  has  passed  through  the 
washing  for  the  remission  of  sins  and  new 
birth,  and  so  lives  as  Christ  commanded. 
For  not  as  common  bread  or  common  drink 
do  we  receive  these;  but  in  like  manner  as 
Jesus  Christ  our  Saviour,  having  become 
incarnate  by  the  Word  of  (jod,  formed  both 
flesh  and  blood  for  our  salvation,  so  likewise 
have  we  been  taught  that  the  food  which  is 
blessed  by  the  utterance  in  prayer  of  His 
Word  (or  of  the  Word  derived  from  Him),  is 
the  flesh  and  blood  of  that  incarnate  Jesus. 
Per  the  Apostles,  in  the  memoirs  which  they 
wrote,  which  are  called  Gospels,  transmitted 
to  us  that  Jesus  Christ  thus  charged  them  ; 
that  after  taking  bread  and  giving  thanks. 
He  said,  "  Do  this  in  remembrance  of  me : 
this  is  My  body; "  and  in  like  manner,  after 
taking  the  cup  and  giving  thanks,  He  said, 
'  This  is  My  Blood,'  and  gave  it  after  conse- 
cration to  all   present,  and  probably  in  a 
certain  order."     This  order  is  further  illus- 
trated in  the  second  book  of  the  Apostolical 
Constitutions,  C.  liv.  c.  4,  where  mention  is 
made  of  each  rank  severally  partaking  of 
the  Lord's  Body  and  of  the  precious  Blood, 
"  approaching  as  to  the  Body  of  a  king,"  and 
of  "  the  women  drawing  near  with  veiled 
heads,   as  becomes  the  rank  of   women." 
Origen  (In  Exodum,  Hom.  xi.   c.  7)  also 
distinctly  states  that  "  after  the  sermon  the 
people  drew  near  to  the  Marriage  Supper  of 
the  Lamb,"  and  "  that  not  the  priest  only, 
but    the  faithful    also  who  were  present, 
received    the    Sacrament;"  and  we  learn 
much    the    same    from    St.    Cyril    (JJat. 
Mystag.  20,  22)  of  Jerusalem,  c.  a.d.  350. 
One  class  only  seems  to  have  been  permitted 
to  be  present  without  commimicating,  viz. 
the  consistentes,  or  fourth  class  of  penitents. 
IV.  Reception  under  hoth  kinds. — -In  none 
of  the  above,  or  in  fact  any  early  accounts 
of  the  administration  of  the  Holy  Eucharist, 
do  we  find  any  trace  of  the  reception  other- 
wise than  under  both  hinds.     This  is  ad- 
mitted even  by  Cardinal  Bona  (Ser.  Liturg. 
ii.  18),  who  acknowledges  that  "  the  faithful 
always  and  in  all  places,  from  the  first  begin- 
nings of  the  Church  till  the  twelfth  century, 
were  used  to  communicate  under  the  species 
of  bread  and  wine"  and  the  Council  of 
Constance  itself  confesses  that "  in  the  primi- 
tive Church  this  Sacrament  was  received  in 
both  kinds  by  the  people."     The  danger  ot 
spilling  the  consecrated  wine  led  to  the  dis- 
continuance of  administering   the  chalice, 
but  only  at  a  very  late  period ;  and  the  Greek 
Church,  more  ancient  than  the  Eoman, "  still 


HOLY  COMMUNION 


3S3 


communicates  her  eighty  millions  nf  believers 
in  both  kinds."  There  were  three  diff'M-ent 
ways  by  which  the  laity  were  communicated 
with  the  consecrated  wine :  either  the  deacon 
put  the  chalice  to  their  moulhs,  which  was 
the  method  anciently  in  use ;  or  they  sucked 
the  wine  through  a  reed  or  pipe,  which  was 
the  custom  generally  in  the  middle  ages;  or 
they  took  the  Lord's  Body  dipped  in  the 
consecrated  wine,  which  method  was  uni- 
versally in  use  after  the  twelfth  centurj' 
(Mabillon  in  Prisf.  Sxc.  iii.  Benedict.),  and 
is  still  the  practice  in  the  East. 

V.  Mode  of  reception. — There  is  abundant 
proof  that  the  Eucharistic  bread  was  de- 
livered into  the  hand  of  the  communicant. 
Thus  St.  Augustine  (O.  Litt.  Fetiliani,  ii. 
23)  speaks  of  a  bishop  into  whose  hands 
his  correspondent  was.  wont  to  place  the 
Eucharist ;  Chrysostom  (Hom.  xx.  ad  Pof. 
Antioch.  c.  7)  speaks  of  the  need  of  having 
dean  hands  to  receive  the  holy  species ;  and 
Ambrose  asks  Theodosius  (Theodoret,  Hist. 
Eccles.  V.  17)  how  he  could  venture  to  receive 
the  Lord's  Body  in  the  hands  still  drijiping 
with  the  murder  of  innocent  persons.  The 
custom  was  for  the  men  to  hold  out  the  naked 
right  hand,  hollowing  the  palm,  and  placing 
the  left  hand  under  it,  "  as  a  throne  for  the 
right,  as  for  that  which  is  to  receive|a  King  " 
(St.  Cyril  Hierosol.  Cat.  Myst.y.).  Sometimes 
it  was  directed  that  the  hands  should  bo 
disposed  in  the  form  of  a  cross.  But  before 
the  end  of  the  sixth  century  the  women 
were  directed  to  hold  in  their  hands  a  linen 
napkin  (Dominicale),  and  were  not  allowed  to 
receive  the  Body  of  Christ  in  the  naked  hand. 
But  this  custom  was  vmknown  to  the  Greek 
fathers,  and  was  virtually  censured  by  the 
TruUan  Council,  a.d.  692. 

VI.  The  words  used  at  the  administra- 
tion.— In  early  times,  the  celebrant,  as  he 
delivered  the  Eucharist  to  each  individually, 
said,  "  The  Body  of  Christ "  (Apost.  Const. 
viii.  14, 3).  "  Audis  enim  Corpus  Christi,  et 
responses.  Amen."  August.  Serm.  272) ;  or 
according  to  the  Liturgy  of  St.  Mark,  "  The 
Holy  Body  ; "  and,  as  he  delivered  the  cup, 
"  The  Blood  of  Christ,"  the  "  Cup  of  Life,"  or 
"  the  Precious  Blood  of  our  Lord  and  God 
and  Saviour."  In  the  time  of  Gregory  the 
Great  he  said,  "  The  Body  of  our  Lord  Jesus 
Christ  preserve  thy  soul,"  to  which,  by  the 
time  of  Alcuin,  was  added,  "  unto  everlasting 
life."  Another  form  was,  "  The  Body  and 
Blood  of  the  Lord  avail  (prosit)  thee  for  the 
remission  of  sins,  and  for  everlasting  life" 
(Ex  Sacram.  Gregoriano — "  Corpus  Domini 
et  Sanguis  prosit  tibi  ad  rcmissionem  pecca- 
torum  et  ad  Vitam  Eeteruam  ").  The  usual 
form  in  England  appears  to  have  been, "  The 
Body  of  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ  preserve  thy 
body  and  soul  unto  everlasting  life." 

VII.  The  responsive  Amen. — To  the  words 


384 


HOLY  COMMUNION 


of  the  celebrant  the  communicant  answered 
in  ancient  times,  "  Amen."  This  custom  is 
attested  in  the  East  by  the  Apostolical  Con- 
stitutions and  St.  Cyril  {Gat.  Myst.  c.  v.), 
and  in  the  West  by  Tertullian  {De  Spectac. 
c.  25),  Augustine,  Jerome  and  Leo.  It  is  di- 
rected in  the  Scotch  Liturgy  of  1637,  and 
is  recommended  by  Bishops  Andrewes  and 
Cosin. 

VIII.  Days  of  Communion. — ^The  words 
of  St.  Luke  in  Acts  ii.  46  are  generally  under- 
stood to  prove  that  "the  breaking  of  the 
bread"  for  Holy  Commrmion  took  place  daily 
in  the  primitive  Church.  When  St.  Paul  is 
represented  as  "breaking  bread"  solemnly 
it  was  on  the  Lord's  Day,  the  first  day  of 
the  week  (Acts  xx.  7) ;  and  when  in  his  first 
Epistle  to  the  Corinthians  (xvi.  1)  he  orders 
collections  to  be  made  on  the  first  day  of 
the  week,  he  seems  to  have  desired  to 
associate  alms-giving  with  the  celebration 
of  the  Holy  Eucharist.  Pliny  (Epist.  x.  97) 
represents  the  Bithynian  Christians  as- 
sembling for  the  Eucharist  "stato  die," 
and  this  day  Justin  Martyr  distinctly 
identifies  with  Sunday,  "  the  day  on  which 
God  made  the  light,  and  on  which  Christ 
arose  from  the  dead."  But  as  early  as  the 
second  century  Christians  in  the  West  had 
celebrations  on  three  days  in  the  week,  i.e. 
on  the  Lord's  Day,  and  on  station  days, 
i.e.  Wednesdays  and  Fridays  (TertuU. 
de  Oratione,  c.  19,  "  Statio  solvenda  ao- 
cepto  Corpore  Domini ").  To  these,  in  the 
fourth  century,  a  fourth  was  added,  though 
chiefly  in  the  Eastern  Church,  viz.  the 
Sabbath,  or  Saturday  (Basil,  Epist.  289). 
But  in  process  of  time,  daily  celebration 
of  the  Holy  Eucharist  became  general, 
though  there  was  no  uniformity  of  discipline 
in  the  different  Churches  (St.  August.  Ep. 
118,  ad  JanvAir. :  "  Alibi  nulla  dies  quo  non 
offeretur;  alibi  Sabbato  tantum  et  Dominico ; 
alibi  tantum  Dominico  ").  For  while  in  some 
no  day  passed  without  a  celebration  (Cyprian, 
Epist.  98,  c.  9 ;  de  Orat.  Dom.  xiii.),  in 
others  it  was  only  on  the  Sabbath  and  on 
the  Lord's  Day ;  in  others  only  on  the  Lord's 
Day.  After  the  sixth  century,  however,  as 
is  plain  from  the  Gelasian  and  Gregorian 
Sacramentaries,  a  daily  celebration  was 
common  in  all  the  Churches,  and  probably 
few,  if  any,  exceptions  can  be  found  in 
mediajval  times.  In  the  Prayer  Book  of 
1549,  a  rubric  before  the  first  exhortation 
makes  provision  for  daily  celebrations. 

IX.  Hour  of  Celebration. — When  in  Acts 
XX.  7,  8,  we  find  St.  Paul  "  breaking  bread  " 
in  the  Troad,  it  is  clear  that  the  service  took 
place  after  nightfall,  and  was  not  concluded 
before  midnight.  Pliny  {Ep.  x.  97)  tells  us 
that  the  Christians  were  accustomed  to  meet 
before  dawn,  and  while  the  persecutions 
against  the  Church  lasted.  Christians  held 


HOLY-DAY 

their  services  by  night.  Hence  Tertullian; 
{Apdl.  c.  2  ;  de  Cor.  Mil.  c.  3)  calls  their  as- 
semblies meetings  held  "  before  daybreak," 
and  "in  the  night-time;"  and  Origen  tells 
Celsus  (c.  Celsum,  i.  3)  that  it  was  to  avoid 
the  death  with  which  they  were  threatened, 
that  the  faithful  met  together  in  secrecy  and 
darkness.  But  when  the  Church  received 
her  liberty  and  peace,  set  hours  began  ta 
be  appointed  for  celebrations.  On  Sundays 
and  festivals  the  third  hour  of  the  day  (nine 
o'clock),  when  the  Holy  Spirit  descended 
upon  the  Apostles,  was  fixed ;  on  ordinarj' 
days,  at  the  sixth  hour  (twelve  o'clock) ; 
in  Lent  and  on  other  fast  days,  the  ninth 
hour  (three  o'clock) ;  and  this  discipline 
was  kept  up  even  down  to  the  twelfth 
century;  it  was  relaxed,  however,  in  the 
thirteenth,  and  by  the  fourteenth  century 
celebrations  took  place  at  any  hour  between 
sunrise  and  noon.  Nightly  celebrations- 
were  common  in  the  middle  ages  on  the  eves 
of  Christmas,  Easter,  and  Pentecost,  and  on 
the  Saturdays  of  the  Ember  weeks. 

X.  Frequency  of  Communion.  —  The 
rubric  at  the  close  of  our  service  requires 
that  "  every  parishioner  shall  communicate 
at  the  least  three  times  in  the  year,  of  which 
Easter  is  to  be  one."  The  ancient  rule  of 
the  Church  seems  to  have  considered  weekly 
communion  essential,  and  to  fail  in  this  was 
to  be  unworthy  of  Christian  privileges. 
Theodore  of  Tarsus  testifies,  about  a.d.  698, 
that  this  was  the  rule  of  the  Church  in  the 
Bast  in  his  day.  In  the  West  the  rule  was 
at  an  early  period  relaxed.  Councils  held  at 
Agde,  A.D.  506,  and  Autun,  a.d.  670,  decreed 
that "  laymen  who  did  not  communicate  at 
Christmas,  Easter,  and  Pentecost,  were  not 
to  be  considered  as  Catholics."  "  Let  every 
one  who  understands  his  own  need,"  says  the 
Council  of  Ensham  under  St.  Alphege,  a.d. 
1009,  "  prepare  himself  to  go  to  Housel 
(Communion)  at  least  thrice  in  the  year,  so 
as  it  is  requisite  for  him."    [G.  F.  M.] 

HOLY-DAY.  The  day  of  some  eccle- 
siastical festival.  The  rubric  after  the 
Nicene  Creed  directs  that  "the  curate 
shall  then  declare  to  the  people  what  holy- 
days  or  fasting  days  are  in  the  week  fol- 
lowing to  be  observed." 

Canon  64.  "  Every  parson,  vicar,  or  cu- 
rate shall,  in  his  several  charge,  declare  to 
the  people  every  Sunday,  at  the  time  ap- 
pointed in  the  Communion  Book,  whether 
there  be  any  holy-days  or  fasting  days  the 
week  following.  And  if  any  do  hereafter 
willingly  offend  herein,  and,  being  once 
admonished  thereof  by  his  ordinary,  shall 
again  omit  that  duty,  let  him  be  censured 
according  to  law  until  he  submit  himself 
to  the  due  performance  of  it." 

Canon  13.  "  All  manner  of  persons 
within  the  Church  of  England  shall  from 


HOLY  GHOST 

henceforth  celebrate  and  keep  the  Lord's 
day,  commonly  called  Sunday,  and  other 
holy-days,  according  to  God's  will  and 
pleasure,  and  the  orders  of  the  Church  of 
England  prescribed  on  that  behalf:  that 
is,  in  hearing  the  word  of  God  read  and 
taught,  in  private  and  pubhc  prayers,  in 
acknowledging  their  offences  to  God,  and 
amendment  of  the  same,  in  reconciling 
themselves  charitably  to  their  neighbours 
where  displeasure  has  often  been,  in  often- 
times receiving  the  communion  of  the  body 
and  blood  of  Christ,  in  visiting  of  the  poor 
and  sick,  using  all  godly  and  sober  con- 
versation." 

Canou  14.  "  The  Common  Prayer  shall 
be  said  or  sung  distinctly  and  reverently 
upon  such  days  as  are  appointed  to  be  kept 
holy  by  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer,  and 
their  eves." 

HOLY  GHOST.  The  thhd  Person  of 
the  adorable  Trinity. 

"  The  Holy  Ghost,  proceeding  from  the 
Father  and  the  Son,  is  one  of  substance, 
majesty,  and  glory  with  the  Father  and 
the  Son,  very  and  eternal  GoA."— Article  V. 

The  name  Ohost,  or  Gast,  in  the  ancient 
Saxon,  signifies  a  spirit,  to  which  the  word 
holy  is  applied,  as  signifying  a  communica- 
tion of  the  Divine  holiness.  Having  been 
baptized  "  in  the  name  of  the  Father,  and 
of  the  Son,  and  of  the  Holy  Ghost,"  we 
cannot  say  with  the  ignorant  disciples,  that 
"we  have  not  so  much  as  heard  whether 
there  be  any  Holy  Ghost "  (Acts  xix.  2)  ; 
we  are  therefore  called  upon  to  believe  in 
the  Holy  Ghost  as  we  do  in  the  Father 
and  the  Son;  and  for  our  authority  in 
considering  him  to  be  a  person  as  well  as 
the  others,  we  have  not  only  the  analogy 
of  faith,  but  sufiicient  evidence  in  holy 
writ. 

First,  he  is  plainly  distinguishable  from 
the  others ;  from  the  Father,  as  proceeding 
from  Him  (St.  John  xv.  26),  and  from  the 
Father  and  the  Son,  in  being  sent  by  one 
from  the  other;  "  The  Comforter,  whom  I," 
says  our  Lord,  "will  send  unto  you  from 
the  Father ; "  "  If  I  go  not  away,  the 
Comforter  will  not  come  unto  you,  but  if  I 
depart,  I  will  send  him  unto  you  "  (St.  John 
XV.  26 ;  xvi.  7).  This  was  the  Spirit  pro- 
mised before  of  the  Father  (Isa.  xliv. 
3 ;  Ezek.  xxxvi.  25,  with  St.  Johu  xiv.  16 ; 
Acts.  i.  4 ;  ii.  33).  He  is  sometimes  termed 
"  the  Spirit  of  the  Son,"  as  well  as  of  the 
Father  (Gal.  iv.  6),  and  is  given  by  the 
Father  (Eph.  i.  17),  and  sent  in  his  Son's 
name  (St.  John  xiv.  26),  as  at  other  times 
by  the  Son  (St.  John  xv.  26  ;  xvi.  7  ;  xx. 
21,  22).  "Blasphemy  against  the  Holy 
Ghost"  (St.  Matt.  xii.  31)  can  only  be 
against  a  person. 

Secondly,  such  properties,  attributes,  and 


HOLY  GHOST 


385 


acts  are  ascribed  to  him  as  are  only  appli- 
cable to  a  person.  He  is  spoken  of  in 
formal  opposition  to  evil  spirits,  who  arc 
clearly  represented  as  persons  (1  Sam.  xvi. 
14  ;  2  Chron.  xviii.  20,  21)  ;  and  if  expres- 
sions are  used  not  exactly  suitable  to  our 
conceptions  of  a  person,  this  may  well  be 
allowed  without  its  making  him  a  mere 
quality  or  attribute.  When  God  is  said  to 
"give"  the  Holy  Ghost  "to  them  that 
obey  him"  (Acts  v.  32),  it  may  be  com- 
pared with  similar  passages  respecting  the 
Son  :  "  God  so  loved  the  world,  that  he 
gave  his  only  begotten  Son,"  &c.  (St.  John 
iii.  16),  in  conformity  to  the  prophecy, 
"  Unto  us  a  Son  is  given"  (Isa.  ix.  6). 

Thirdly,  he  is  also  truly  God,  as  is 
proved  from  the  titles  given  to  him  by  fair 
implication  (Acts  v.  3,  4 ;  St.  Luke  i.  35 ;  and 
see  2  Sam.  xxiii.  2,  3),  and  the  attributes 
of  God  (Job  xxxiii.  4 ;  Ps.  cxxxix.  7 ;  Isa. 
xlviii.  16 ;  with  Acts  xiii.  2 ;  xx.  28 ;  St. 
Mark  xiii.  11 ;  Eom.  viii.  14 ;  xv.  13,  19 ;  1 
Cor.  ii.  11),  and  he  is  in  two  grand  instances 
united  to  the  Father  and  the  Son,  in 
perfect  equality, — the  form  of  baptism,  by 
which  we  are  admitted  into  the  Church  of 
God  (St.  Matt,  xxviii.  19),  and  the  apostolic 
benediction,  the  common  Christian  saluta- 
tion (2  Cor.  xiii.  14). 

As  he  is  the  Holy  Spirit  of  God,  "the 
Spirit  of  holiness"  (Rom.  i.  4),  so  is  he 
the  cause  of  all  holiness  in  man.  That  as 
the  Son,  by  his  sacrifice,  put  us  in  the  way 
of  salvation  (St.  John  iii.  16),  so  must  the 
Holy  Spirit  co-operate  in  sealing  "  us 
unto  the  day  of  redemption,"  through  his 
"  sanctifioation,"  and  "  belief  of  the  truth  " 
(Eom.  viii.  16  ;  2  Cor.  i.  22  ;  v.  5 ;  Gal.  vi. 
8;  Eph.  i.  13,  14;  iv.  30;  Phil.  i.  19; 
2  Thess.  ii.  13 ;  Tit.  iii.  5),  according  as 
he  has  been  promised  (Jer.  xxxii.  40; 
Ezek.  xxxvi.  27 ;  St.  John  vi.  44).  And 
this  he  does  by  regenerating  us  at  baptism 
(St.  Matt.  iii.  11 ;  St.  John  iii.  5  ;  Gal.  iv. 
29 ;  Tit.  iii.  5),  and  making  us  the  "  sons 
of  God"  (Rom.  viii.  14-16;  Gal.iv.  6),  and 
thus  uniting  us  to  our  "head"  (1  Cor.  vi. 
17  ;  xii.  12,  13 ;  Eph.  iv.  4;  1  St.  John  iii. 
24),  and  by  instructing  us  in  our  duty 
(Prov.  i.  23;  Ps.  clxiii.  10;  Isa.  lix.  21;  1 
Cor.  ii.  10,  11 ;  xii.  3  ;  2  Cor.  iii.  3 ;  Gal.  v. 
16,  25),  illuminating  the  understanding 
(Neh.  ix.  20;  Isa.  xxxii.  15,  16;  Ezek. 
xxxvi.  27 ;  Mioah  iii.  8 ;  Rom.  viii.  2,  5 ; 
Eph.  i.  17,  18 ;  1  St.  John  iii.  24 ;  iv.  13), 
disposing  the  will  (Heb.  iii.  7,  8;  1  Pet.  i. 
2,  22),  settling  us  in  the  faith  and  love  of 
God  (Rom.  V.  5 ;  2  Cor.  iv.  13  ;  2  Tim.  i. 
7),  giving  us  power  to  obey  (Zech.  iv.  6 ; 
2  Cor.  iii.  17 ;  Eph.  iii.  16),  helping  us  in 
prayer  (Zech.  xii.  10 ;  Eom.  viii.  26  ;  1  Cor. 
xiv.  15 ;  St.  Jude  20),  and  sanctifying  ns 
(Rom.  XV.  16;    1  Cor.  vi.  11;  Gal.  v.  10). 

2  c 


386 


HOLY  INNOCENTS 


And  as  liis  very  name,  "  tlie  Comforter," 
implies,  he  gives  consolation  and  joy  (Acts 
ix.  31 ;  Eom.  xiv.  17;  xv.  13;  Gal.  v.  22; 
1  Thess.  i.  6). 

It  is  necessary,  then,  that  we  believe  in 
the  Holy  Ghost,  as  having  been  baptised  to 
God  in  his  name ;  and  as  we  would  receive  the 
apostolic  benediction  (2  Cor.  xiii.  14 ;  Phil, 
il  1),  and  enjoy  the  kingdom  of  God  on 
earth,  which  is  "  righteousness,  and  peace, 
and  joy,"  in  him  (Rom.  xiv.  17;  Acts 
xiii.  52)  (See  Procession ;  Trinity). 

HOLY  INNOCENTS.  This  festival  is 
alluded  to  by  St.  Cyprian  (Ep.  56,  al.  58), 
St.  Hilary  (in  Matt.  can.  1),  St.  Augus- 
tine (de  Syrrib.  1.  3,  c.  4),  and  other  early 
writers,  who  speak  of  it  as  of  immemorial 
observance.  In  many  churches  in  England 
a  muffied  peal  is  rung  on  this  day  (See 
Innocents').     [H.] 

HOLY  TABLE  (Syw  rpamia)  (See 
Altar).  The  altar  on  which  the  appointed 
memorials  of  the  death  of  Christ,  namely, 
the  bread  and  wine,  are  presented  before 
God,  as  an  oblation  of  thanksgiving,  is 
called  the  Lord's  table,  or  the  holy  table ; 
because  his  worshippers  do  there,  as  his 
guests,  eat  and  drink  these  consecrated 
elements,  in  faith,  to  be  thereby  fed  and 
nourished  unto  eternal  life,  by  Ihe  spiritual 
food  of  his  most  precious  body  and  blood. 

HOLY  THURSDAY.  The  day  of  our 
Lord's  ascension  (See  Ascension  Day). 

HOLY  WEEK :  called  also  the  "  Great 
Week ; "  the  "  Indulgence  Week  "  (from  the 
great  Absolution  at  Easter) ;  and  "  Passion 
Week."  The  week  before  Easter.  Its  ob- 
servance is  of  great  antiquity,  probably 
dating  \ip  to  the  time  of  the  Apostles. 
Dionysius,  bishop  of  Alexandria,  the  pupil 
and  friend  of  Oiigen,  speaks  of  it  as  generally 
observed  in  his  days.  "Some,"  he  says, 
"  continue  the  whole  six  days  without  eat- 
ing ;  some  add  two  days  together,  some 
three,  some  four"  (^Episf.  Canon,  can.  1). 
Epiphauius  and  other  early  historians  refer 
frequently  to  this  holy  season,  and  St.  Chiy- 
sostom  in  more  than  one  place  gives  an 
account  of  how  it  was  observed  {Horn.  vi. 
in  Gen. ;  Eom.  in  Ps.  cxlv.,  ifec.).  "  While 
this  week  brings  to  a  climax  the  penitence 
and  self-discipline  of  Lent,  it  naturally 
absorbs  both  into  the  adoring  contemplation 
of  the  Passion  and  Resurrection  of  our  Lord." 
— Bp.  Barry,  P.  B.  p.  78  (See  Maundy- 
Tliursday ;  Good  Friday ;  Easter  Eve  ; 
Lent).     [H.] 

HOLY  WATER  (See  Water). 

HOMILY.  Prom  ojiiXla,  a  word  which 
implies,  in  the  first  place,  "  intercourse." 
1.  It  was  used  specially  to  denote  the 
teaching  of  a  philosopher  in  his  school, 
which  was  given  in  familiar  conversation. 
In  ecclesiastical  language  it  always  implied 


HOMILY 

a  religious  address,  founded  on  some  passage 
of  Scripture.  The  earliest  homilies  known 
are  those  of  Origen ;  but  those  of  St.  Clement 
of  Alexandria,  of  St.  Chiysostom,  of  St. 
Augustine,  St.  Athanasius,  St.  Gregory 
Nazianzen,  and  of  many  other  Fathers,  are 
expositions  of  the  Scriptures  of  the  highest 
value.  St.  Augustine  gave  it  as  his  opinion 
that  "  those  who  have  a  good  delivery,  but 
no  power  of  composition,  should  adopt  the 
sermons  of  others  "  (De.  Doct.  Ohr.  iv.  62). 
Prom  this  arose  the  formation  of  collections 
of  homilies  or  sermons,  which  were  much 
used  (Mabillon,  Acta  S.  S.,  Bened.  iii.  pt.  i. 
p.  556),  and  in  medieval  times  Homilaria, 
or  books  of  homilies,  were  widely  circulated 
among  the  clergy  (Scudamore's  Notitia 
Eucharistica,  290). 

II.  The  Homilies  of  the  Church  of 
England  are  two  books  of  plain  discourses, 
composed  at  the  time  of  the  Reformation, 
and  appointed  to  be  read  in  churches,  on 
"any  Sunday  or  holy-day,  when  there  is 
no  sermon."  The  first  volume  of  them  was 
set  out  in  the  beginning  of  King  Edward 
the  Sixth's  teigu  in  1547,  having  been 
composed  (as  it  is  thought)  by  Archbishop 
Cranmer  and  Bishops  Ridley  and  Latimer, 
when  a  competent  number  of  ministers  of 
sufficient  abilities  to  preach  in  a  public 
congregation  was  not  to  be  found.  It  was 
reprinted  m  1560.  The  second  book  ap- 
peared in  1563,  having  been  printed  the 
year  before  (see  Strype's  Life  of  Parker), 
in  the  reign  of  Elizabeth.  Bishop  Jewell  is 
supposed  to  have  had  a  great  share  in  its 
composition.  In  the  first  book,  the  homily 
on  "  Salvation "  was  probably  written  by 
Cranmer,  as  also  those  on  "  Faith "  and 
"Good  Works."  The  homilies  on  the 
"  Pear  of  Death,"  and  on  the  "  Reading  of 
Scripture,"  have  likewise  been  ascribed  to 
the  archbishop.  That  on  the  "Misery  of 
Mankind,"  which  has  sometimes  been  attri- 
buted to  him,  appears  in  Bishop  Bonner's 
volume  of  Homilies,  a.d.  1555,  with  the 
name  of  "  Jo.  Harpesfield "  attached  to  it. 
The  homilies  on  "  the  Passion,"  and  on  "  the 
Resurrection,"  are  from  Taverner's  "Postills," 
published  in  1540.  Internal  evidence  arising 
out  of  certain  homely  expressions,  and  pe- 
culiar forms  of  ejaculation,  the  like  to 
which  appear  in  Latimer's  sermons,  pretty 
clearly  betray  the  hand  of  the  Bishop  of 
Worcester  to  have  been  engaged  in  the 
homily  against  "  Brawhng  and  Conten- 
tion ; "  the  one  against  "  Adultery  "  may 
be  safely  given  to  Thomas  Becon,  one  of 
Cranmer's  chaplains,  in  whose  works, 
published  in  1564,  it  is  still  to  be  found; 
of  the  rest  nothing  is  known  hut  by  the 
merest  conjecture.  In  the  second  book,  no 
single  homily  of  them  all  has  been  appro- 
priated. 


HOMOIOUSION 

The  authors  of  several  of  the  Homilies 
-are  mentioned  in  Corry's  recent  edition  of 
them,  who  also  shows  how  they  were  in- 
tended to  bear  upon  the  Antinomian  as  well 
as  the  Popish  errors  of  the  day  (See  also 
'Griffith's  Kd.  of  the  Eomilies). 

It  would  seem  that  the  Homilies  were 
written  in  haste,  and  the  Church  did  wisely 
to  reserve  the  authority  of  correcting  them 
-and  setting  forth  others  (See  Evhric 
lefore  Offertory).  For  they  have  many 
errors  in  them  in  special,  although  they 
'Contain  in  general  many  wholesome  les- 
sons for  the  people. 

HOMOIOUSION  (5,iotou<nor) :  "of  a 
similar  substance  "  with  the  Father.  The 
;term  was  invented  in  the  Arian  controversy 
as  a  sort  of  middle  idea  between  that  of  the 
'Catholic  belief  in  Homoousion,  or  "same 
substance,"  and  the  extreme  opinion  of  Arius, 
who  held  that  Christ  was  unlike  the  Father, 
being  a  mere  created  Being  (See  Avians ; 
■Creed).  -These  senu-Arians  held  that  the 
nature  of  God  the  Son,  though  not  the 
-same,  was  similar  to  that  of  God  the 
Father.     [H.] 

HOMOOUSION  (6/xoovo-tof)  (See  Tri- 
nity). This  is  the  critical  word  of  the 
JSTicene  Creed,  and  is  used  to  express  the 
real  Divinity  of  Christ,  and  that,  as  derived 
from,  and  one  with,  the  Father.  The  word 
was  adopted  from  the  necessity  of  the  case, 
in  a  sense  different  from  the  ordinary  philo- 
sophical use  of  it.  'Ofwovcnos  properly  means 
of  the  same  nature,  i.e.  under  the  same 
general  nature,  or  species ;  and  it  is  appUed  to 
things  which  are  but  similar  to  each  other, 
and  are  considered  as  one  by  an  abstraction 
-of  our  minds.  Thus  Aristotle  speaks  of  the 
stars  being  ojioovcna  with  each  other ;  and 
Porphyry,  of  the  souls  of  brute  animals  being 
■oiioovcrtai  to  ours.  When,  however,  it  was 
used  in  relation  to  the  incommunicable 
essence  of  God,  there  was  obviously  no 
-abstraction  possible  in  contemplating  Him, 
who  is  above  aU  comparison  with  His  works. 
His  nature  is  solitary,  peculiar  to  Himself, 
;and  one ;  so  that,  whatever  was  accounted 
to  be  ofjLoova-tos  with  Him,  was  necessarily 
included  in  His  individuality  by  all  who 
would  avoid  recurring  to  the  vagueness  of 
jihilosophy,  and  were  cautious  to  distmguish 
between  the  incommunicable  essence  of 
■Jehovah  and  all  created  intelligences.  And 
ience  the  fitness  of  the  term  to  denote 
without  metaphor  the  relation  which  the 
Logos  bore  in  the  orthodox  creed  to  his 
•eternal  Father.  Its  use  is  explained  by 
Athanasius  as  follows  :  "  Though,"  he  says, 
"  we  cannot  understand  what  is  meant  by 
the  oia-ia  of  God,  yet  we  know  as  much  as 
this,  that  God  exists  (flvm),  which  is  the 
way  in  which  Scripture  speaks  of  him ;  and 
•after  this  pattern,  when  we  wish  to  designate 


HOOD 


387 


him  distinctly  we  say,  God,  Father,  Lord. 
When  then  we  read  in  Scripture,  'I  am 
6  &v,'  and  'I  am  Jehovah,  God,'  or  the 
plain  word,  '  God,'  we  understand  by  such 
statements  nothing  but  His  incomprehensible 
ovala,  and  that  He,  who  is  there  spoken  of, 
exists  (Ja-rlv).  Let  no  one  then  think  it 
strange,  that  the  Son  of  God  should  be  said 
to  be  eK  rijs  oicrias  tou  GeoC,  of  the  substance 
of  God ;  rather,  let  him  agree  to  the  expla- 
nation of  the  Nicene  Fathers,  who,  for  the 
words  £K  eeoO,  substituted  tlie  ck  rrjs  ova-Las. 
They  considered  the  two  phrases  substanti- 
ally the  same,  because,  as  we  have  said,  the 
word  God  denotes  nothing  but  the  ouo-i'a 
avTov  roO  ovtos  .  On  the  other  band,  if 
the  Word  be  not  in  such  sense  e<  ro€  OfoC, 
as  to  be  the  true  Son  of  the  Father  accord- 
ing to  his  nature,  but  be  said  to  be  «  rov 
Qeov,  merely  as  all  creatures  are  such  as 
being  bis  work,  then  indeed  he  is  not  in  ttjs 
oiiirlas  tov  Uarpos,  nor  Son  /car'  ova-lav, 
but  so  called  from  his  virtue,  as  we  may  be 
who  receive  the  title  from  grace." 

Bishop  BuU  says  that  o/xoovaios  is  used 
by  standard  Greek  writers  to  signify  that 
which  is  of  the  same  substance,  essence,  or 
nature.  And  he  shows  at  large  that  the 
term  was  not  invented  by  the  Nicene 
Fathers,  but  was  known  in  its  present 
theological  acceptation  long  before ;  by 
Irenajus,  by  Origen  (as  Dionysius  of  Alex- 
andria and  Athanasius  testify),  by  Gregory 
Thaumaturgus,  &c.  See  the  2nd  section  of 
the  treatise,  "  Defeiisio  Fidei  Nicxnse."  See 
also  Suicer  in  voc,  from  which  it  appears  that 
the  ante-Nicene  Fathers  defined  the  word  as 
signifying  "  that  which  is  of  the  same  nature, 
essence,  eternity,  and  energy,"  without  any 
difierence  (See  Creed). 

HOOD.  Sax.  hod.  The  hood,  as  used  by 
us,  is  partly  derived  from  the  monastic 
caputium,  partly  from  the  canonical  amice, 
or  almufium.  It  was  formerly  used  by  the 
laity  as  well  as  the  clergy,  and  by  the 
monastic  orders.  In  cathedral  and  collegiate 
churches,  the  hoods  of  the  canons  and  pre- 
bendaries were  frequently  lined  with  fur  or 
wool,  and  always  worn  in  the  choir.  The 
term  almutium,  or  amice,  was  peculiarly 
applied  to  these  last.  And  such  is  the 
present  usage  in  foreign  churches,  where  the 
capitular  canons  are  generally  distinguished 
from  the  inferior  members,  by  the  colour  or 
materials  of  the  ahnuce  (See  Arhice). — 
Palmer,  Orig.  Liturg.  vol.  ii.  409. 

As  used  in  England  and  Ireland,  it  is  an 
ornamental  folded  cloth  of  some  material 
that  hangs  down  the  back  of  a  graduate  to 
mark  his  degree.  This  part  of  the  dress 
was  formerly  not  intended  for  distinction 
and  ornament,  but  for  use.  It  was  gene- 
rally fastened  to  the  back  of  the  cope  or 
other  vesture,  and  in  case  of  rain  or  cold 

2  c  2 


388 


HOBN-BOOKS 


was  drawn  over  the  head.  In  the  universities 
the  hoods  of  the  graduates  were  made  to 
signify  their  degrees  by  varying  the  colours 
and  materials.  The  hoods  at  our  three  prin- 
cipal universities,  Oxford,  Cambridge,  and 
Dublin,  vary  considerably  from  one  another : 
with  this  agreement,  that  all  Doctors  are 
distinguished  by  a  scarlet  hood,  the  linings 
varying  according  to  the  different  faculties. 
Originally  however  it  would  appear  that 
they  were  the  same,  probably  till  after  the 
Eestoration.  Masters  of  Arts  had  originally 
fur  hoods,  like  the  proctors  at  Oxford,  whose 
dress  is  in  fact  that  of  full  costume  of  a. 
Master  of  Arts  ;  Bachelors  in  other  faculties 
wore  silk  hoods  of  some  intermediate  colour ; 
and  Bachelors  of  Arts  stuff  hoods  lined  with 
lambs'  wool.  The  hoods  in  the  Scottish 
universities  followed  the  pattern  of  those  of 
theuniversity  of  Paris. — Jebh,Ohoral  Service. 

By  the  58th  Canon,  every  minister  saying 
the  public  prayers,  or  ministering  the  sacra- 
ments, or  other  rites  of  the  Church,  if  they 
are  graduates,  shall  wear  upon  their  surplice, 
at  such  times,  such  hoods  as  by  the  orders 
of  the  universities  are  agreeable  to  their 
degrees. 

[The  receivers  of  Lambeth  degrees  wear 
the  hood  of  such  degrees  as  are  worn  at  the 
University  of  the  archbishop  who  gives 
them.  Sundry  theological  colleges  have 
taken  upon  themselves,  with  some  pretended 
licences  from  archbishops,  to  authorise  their 
students  to  wear  hoods  of  their  own  in- 
vention. But  they  are  entirely  illegal 
"  ornaments "  in  church,  so  far  as  they 
differ  from  "a  black  tippet  not  of  silk," 
which  alone  is  lawful  for  non-graduates, 
according  to  Canon  58].    [G.] 

HOliN- BOOKS.  When  books  were 
scarce,  endeavours  were  made  in  the  v?riting 
rooms  of  the  monasteries  to  make  some 
provision  even  for  the  poorest  by  means  of 
Horn-books,  on  which  were  written  the 
Creed,  the  Lord's  Prayer,  and  the  Angelic 
Salutation.  The  writing  was  covered  with 
a  thin  sheet  of  horn  to  prevent  its  being 
thiunhed — hence  the  name.    [H.] 

HOSANNA  (^^3Pi1n  :  ixrawd,  "Save, 
we  pray  ").  At  the  feast  of  Tabernacles,  when 
the  gi-eat  Hcdhl  was  chanted  by  the  priests, 
the  multitude  joined  in  at  intervals,  shout- 
ing "  Hosanna,"  as  they  waved  branches  of 
willow  or  palm ;  and  the  seventh  and  greatest 
day  of  the  feast  was  distinguished  as  the 
great  Hosanna  day — Hosavna  RaVbi  (See 
Ilallel).  According  to  Rabbi  Elias  Levita 
(TMsby,  s.  V.)  the  Jews  call  the  willow 
branches,  which  they  carry  at  the  feast, 
"Hosannas,"  because  they  sing  Hosanna, 
shaking  them  everywhere.  Orotius  observes, 
that  the  feasts  of  the  Jews  did  not  only 
signify  their  going  out  of  Egypt,  the  memory 


HOUR  GLASS 

of  which  they  celebrated,  but  also  the  expec- 
tation of  the  Messias  :  and  that  still  on  the 
day  when  they  carry  those  branches,  they 
wish  to  celebrate  that  feast  at  the  coming  of 
the  Messias ;  from  whence  he  concludes, 
that  the  people  carrying  those  branches 
before  our  Saviour  showed  their  joy,  ac- 
knowledging him  to  be  the  Messias. — ^Bux- 
torf,  Lexic.  Talm.  992,  1143:  Lightfoot, 
Temple  Service,  xvi.  2 ;  Diet,  of  Bible,  s.  v. 

HOSPITALS  were  houses  for  the  relief 
of  poor  and  impotent  persons,  and  were 
generally  incorporated  by  royal  patents,  and 
made  capable  of  gifts  and  grants  in  succes- 
sion. Some  of  these  in  England  are  very 
noble  foundations,  as  St.  Cross  at  Winchester, 
founded  in  the  reign  of  King  Stephen. 
In  most  cathedral  towns  there  are  hospitals, 
often  connected  with  the  cathedrals.  Christ's 
Hospital  in  London  was  one  of  those  many 
excellent  endowments,  to  which  the  funds 
of  alienated  monasteries  would  have  been 
more  largely  directed,  had  secular  avarice 
permitted. 

HOSPITALLERS,  or  Knights  of  St.  John 
of  Jerusalem.  Knights  who  took  their 
name  from  an  hospital  built  in  Jerusalem 
for  the  use  of  pilgrims  coming  to  the  Holy 
Land.  They  were  to  provide  for  such 
pilgrims,  and  to  protect  them  on  the  road. 
They  came  to  England  in  the  year  1100, 
and  here  they  anived  at  such  power  that 
their  superior  had  a  seat  in  the  House  of 
Lords,  and  ranked  as  the  first  lay  baron. 

HOSPITIUM,  or  Domus  Eospitium.  In 
ancient  monasteries,  the  place  where  pil- 
grims and  other  strangers  were  received  and 
entertained. 

HOST.  Erom  hostia,  a  victim.  In  the 
first  place  the  word  meant  any  sacrifice  or 
offering ;  then  it  was  applied  only  to  the 
elements  used  in  the  celebration  of  the 
Eucharist,  more  particularly  to  the  bread 
(See  Wafer').  Romanists  worship  the  host, 
under  a  presumption  that  the  elements  are 
no  longer  bread  and  wine,  but  transub- 
stantiated into  the  real  body  and  blood  of 
Christ.  The  host  was  treated  with  the 
greatest  reverence  in  the  earliest  times,  as 
we  learn  from  Tertullian,  Origen,  St.  Cyril, 
St.  Jerome,  and  many  others,  but  this  does 
not  imply  adoration,  which  was  not  prac- 
tised till  the  twelfth  centiuy. — Bingham, 
bk.  XX.,  V.  (See  Transubstantiation). 

HOSTIARIUS  (See  Ostiarius).  The 
second  master  in  some  of  the  old  endowed 
schools,  as  Winchester,  is  so  called.  Hence 
usher. 

HOUR  GLASS.  The  usual  length  of 
sermons  in  the  English  Church,  from  the 
Reformation  till  the  latter  part  of  the  seven- 
teenth century,  was  an  hour.  Puritans 
preached  much  longer — two,  three,  and  even 
four  hours.     For  the  measurement  of  the 


HOUES  OF  PEAYER 

time  of  sermon,  hour  glasses  were  frequently 
attached  to  pulpits,  and  in  some  churches 
the  stand  for  the  glass,  if  not  the  instrument 
itself,  still  remains. 

HOURS  OP  PRAYER.  I.  The  princi- 
ple of  giving  certain  times  to  prayer  and 
meditation  has  always  been  recognised  and 
encouraged  by  the  Church.  In  Holy  Scrip- 
ture mention  is  made  of  such  hours  being 
observed  by  the  faithful.  The  AiDOstles 
were  assembled  together  at  the  third  hour 
(evidently  the  usual  time  of  meeting),  when 
the  Holy  Spirit  descended  upon  them;  it 
was  at  the  hour  of  prayer — the  ninth  hour 
—that  St.  Peter  and  St.  John  went  to  the 
temple  ;  the  disciples  were  praying  at  mid- 
night when  St.  Peter,  having  been  released 
from  prison,  stood  amongst  them ;  and  it  was 
at  midnight  that  St.  Paul  and  Silas,  pro- 
bably according  to  their  rule,  prayed  and 
sang  praises  unto  God  (Acts  ii.  1 ;  iii.  1 ; 
xii.  12 ;  xvi.  25,  &c.).  Such  hours  of  prayer 
are  mentioned  by  the  earliest  writers ;  and 
Tertullian  speaks  of  them  as  "  hora3  Apo- 
stohcje  "  (Be  Jejuniis,  cap.  10).  It  is  not 
necessary  to  quote  passages  from  St. 
Cyprian,  St.  Basil,  St.  Augustine,  and  many 
others  to  the  purpose.  The  same  hours  of 
the  day  and  night  have  not  always  been  ap- 
pointed for  prayer,  as  under  different  cir- 
cumstances changes  might  have  to  be  made. 
In  times  of  persecution,  for  instance,  the 
hours  for  common  prayer  would  be  at 
liight ;  but  when  the  religion  was  acknow- 
ledged publicly,  the  hom-s  for  prayer  were 
stated.  They  were  (1)  Nocturns  or 
matins,  held  before  daybreak,  at;d  properly  a 
night  service ;  (2)  Lauds,  at  daybreak,  follow- 
ing and  sometimes  joined  with  matins  ;  (3) 
Prime,  about  six  o'clock,  "  the  first  hour  "  ; 
(4)  Tierce  or  terce,  nine  a.m.,  "  the  third 
hour " ;  (5)  Sexts,  at  noon,  "  the  sixth 
hour  "  ;  (6)  Nones,  at  three  p.m.,  ''  the  ninth 
hour";  (7)  Vespers,  in  the  early  evening ; 
(8)  Comphne,  the  last  evening  service.  The 
author  of  the  Apostolic  Constitutions  gives 
precise  directions  with  regard  to  the  hours 
•of  prayer  (lib.  viii.-xxxiv.).  The  Eastern 
offices  for  daily  worship  were  introduced 
into  the  West  in  the  fifth  century,  and  the 
Western  offices  bear  testimony  to  their  in- 
fluence (Freeman's  Princ.  Div.  Serv.  i. 
225).  The  number  of  the  canonical  hours 
was  fixed  at  seven,  viz.  matins  and  lauds, 
prime,  tierce,  sext,  nones,  vespers,  and 
compline.  The  names  given  by  the  Anglo- 
Saxons  to  the  canonical  hours  were  uht- 
sang,  prime-sang,  under-sang,  midday-sang, 
noon-sang,  even-sang,  and  night-sang 
(Wilkins,  Concil.  i.  252).  Later  on  the 
■daily  offices  most  commonly  used  by  the 
laity  were  entitled  "  the  Hours  " ;  and  of 
these  there  were  various  forms,  but  the 
most  famous  was  the  "  Hours  of  the  Blessed  , 


HOUSEL 


389 


Virgin,"  which  was  commonly  called  the 
"  Little  Office,"  to  distinguish  it  from  the 
"  Divine  Office "  or  larger  service  of  the 
Breviary.  This  was  of  great  antiquity,  and 
was  revised  in  1056. 

II.  "The  Chm-ch  of  England,  at  the 
revision  of  our  offices  in  the  reign  of  Edward 
VI.,  only  prescribed  public  woiship  in  the 
morning  and  evening :  and  in  making  this 
regulation  she  was  perfectly  justified :  for 
though  it  is  the  duty  of  Christians  to  pray 
continually,  yet  the  jirecise  times  and 
seasons  of  prayer,  termed  Canonical  Hours, 
do  not  rest  on  any  Divine  command ;  neither 
have  they  ever  been  pronounced  binding 
on  all  Churches  by  any  general  Council; 
neither  has  there  been  any  uniformity  in  the 
practice  of  the  Christian  Church  in  this 
respect."  "  The  office  of  matins,  or  morning 
prayer,  according  to  the  Church  of  England, 
is  a  judicious  abridgment  of  her  ancient 
services  for  matins,  lauds,  and  prime  ;  and 
the  office  of  even-song,  or  evening  prayer,  in 
Uke  manner,  is  an  abridgment  of  the  ancient 
service  for  vespers  and  complme.  Both 
these  offices  have  received  several  improve- 
ments in  imitation  of  the  ancient  discipline 
of  the  Churches  of  Egypt,  Gaul,  and  Spain." 
— Pabner,  Orig.  Liturg.  vol.  i.  204,  212. 

The  offices  for  the  third,  sixth,  and  ninth 
hours,  were  shorter  than  the  others,  and 
were  nearly  the  same  every  day.  Bishop 
Cosin  drew  up,  by  royal  command,  a  form 
of  devotion  for  private  use  for  the  different 
canonical  hours.  It  is  supposed  that  the 
seven  hours  of  prayer  took  their  rise  from 
the  example  of  the  psalm,  "  Seven  times  a 
day  do  I  give  thanks  unto  thee ;  "  but  the 
ancient  usage  of  the  Church  does  not 
sanction  more  than  two  or  three  times  for 
stated  public  prayer  (See  Prymer). — 
Maskell,  Mon.  Hit.  Heel.  Ang.  iii.,  iv.  seq. ; 
Blunt,  l)ict.  Doct.  Theol.  p.  315 ;  Freemau, 
Princ.  Div.  Ser.  i.      [H.] 

HOUSEL  (Saxon,  liusd).  The  blessed 
Eucharist.  Johnson  derives  it  from  the 
Gothic  hunsa,  a  sacrifice,  which  is  probably 
derived  from  a  root  signifying  to  kill.  Todd, 
in  his  emendations,  remarks  on  the  verb 
to  housel,  that  an  old  lexicography  defines 
it  specially,  "  to  administer  the  communion 
to  one  who  lieth  on  his  death-bed."  It  was, 
perhaps,  in  later  times  more  generally  used 
in  this  sense:  still  it  was  often  employed, 
as  we  find  from  Chaucer,  and  writers  as 
late  as  the  time  of  Henry  VIII.,  as  in  Saxon 
times,  to  signify  absolutely  the  receiving  of 
the  Eucharist. — Jebb,  Choral  Service. 

In  the  canons  under  King  Edgar  the 
word  often  occurs — "  We  enjoin,  that  it  never 
happen  that  a  priest  celebrate  mass,  and  not 
taste  the  housel  himself." — Thorpe,  Ancient 
Laws,  vol.  ii.  p.  253.  See  Skeat's  Etymolog. 
Diet. 


390 


HUGH,  ST. 


HUGH,  ST.  Bishop  of  Lincoln.  Bom  at 
Grenoble,  a.d.  1140,  of  noble  parents,  ho 
came  over  to  England  in  1181,  at  the  desire 
of  Henry  II.,  to  preside  over  the  first  Car- 
thusian monastery  in  England,  at  Witham, 
in  Somersetshire.  Five  years  later  he  was 
made  bishop  of  Lincoln,  and  he  rebuilt  the 
cathedral  there.  He  died  in  1200,  at  the 
hour  when  his  clergy  were  singing  the 
"  Nunc  Dimitlis  "  at  compline.  He  is  com- 
memorated in  the  Enghsh  Calendar  on  No- 
vember 17  (See  Canon  Perry's  Life  of  St. 
HugJi).     [H.] 

HUGUENOTS.  A  name  by  which  the 
French  Protestants  were  distinguished,  very 
early  in  their  history.  The  name  is  of 
uncertain  derivation;  some  deduce  it  from 
one  of  the  gates  of  the  city  of  Tours  called 
JIucfon's,  at  which  these  Protestants  held 
their  first  assemblies ;  others  from  the  words 
Hue  nos,  with  which  their  original  protest 
commenced;  others  from  the  German, 
Mdgenossen  (associated  by  oath),  which 
first  became  Egnots,  and  afterwards  Hugue- 
nots. 

The  origin  of  the  sect  in  France  dates 
from  the  reign  of  Francis  I.,  when  the 
principles  and  doctrines  of  the  Gennan  Ee- 
fonners  found  many  disciples  among  their 
Gallic  neighbours.  As  everywhere  else,  so 
in  France,  the  new  doctrines  spread  with 
great  rapidity,  and  called  forth  the  energies 
both  of  Church  and  State  to  repress  them. 
Both  Francis  and  his  successor,  Henry  II., 
placed  the  Huguenots  under  various  penal 
disabilities,  and  they  were  subjected  to 
the  violence  of  the  factious  French  among 
their  opponents,  without  protection  from 
the  State :  but  the  most  horrible  deed 
which  was  perpetrated  against  them  was 
the  massacre  of  St.  Bartholomew's  day 
(See  Bartholomew)  : — a  scene  which  stands 
recorded  in  history,  as  if  to  teach  us  to  how 
great  a.  depth  of  cruelty  and  oppression 
mankind  may  be  driven  by  fanaticism. 

In  the  reign  of  Henry  IV.  the  Huguenots 
were  protected  by  the  edict  of  Nantes, 
which  was  revoked,  however,  in  1685,  by 
Cardinal  Mazarin,  the  minister  of  Louis 
XIV.:  on  this  occasion  300,000  of  this 
persecuted  race  took  refuge  in  the  neigh- 
bouring Protestant  states.  At  the  Eevo- 
lution  the  Huguenots  were  restored  to  their 
rnil  rights,  so  far  as  civil  rights  were  left  to 
any  citizens  of  a  libertine  and  infidel  state. 
In  doctrine  and  discipline  the  Huguenots 
symbolized  with  Calvin  and  the  sect  which 
he  originated  at  Geneva. 

HULSBAN  LECTURES.  Lectures  de- 
livered at  Cambridge,  under  the  will  of  the 
Kev.  John  Hulse,  late  of  Blworth,  bearing 
date  July  12,  1777.  The  number,  originally 
twenty,  is  now  reduced  to  eight. 

HUMANITY  OP   OUR  LORD,  is  His 


HUTGHINSONLAJ^S 

possessing  a  true  human  body  and  a  true- 
human  soul  (See  Jesus). 

HUMBLE  ACCESS,  PRAYER  OF.  The 
prayer  immediately  preceding  the  prayer  of 
consecration  in  the  office  of  Holy  Commu- 
nion (See  Access). 

HUSSITES.  The  followers  of  John. 
Huss,  of  Bohemia,  who  maintained  WicliPs- 
opinions  in  1407,  with  wonderful  zeal. 
The  emperor  Sigismond  sent  to  him  to  per- 
suade him  to  defend  his  doctrioe  before  the 
Council  of  Constance,  which  he  did  a.d. 
1414,  having  obtained  a  passport  and  an. 
assurance  of  safe  conduct  from  the  emperor. 
There  were  seven  months  spent  in  ex- 
amining him,  and  two  bishops  were  sent 
into  Bohemia  to  inform  themselves  of  the 
doctrine  he  preached;  and  for  his  firm  ad- 
herence to  the  same  he  was  condemned  to- 
be  burnt  alive  with  his  books,  which 
sentence  was  executed  in  1415,  contrary  to 
the  safe-conduct,  which  the  Council  of 
Constance  basely  said  that  the  emperor  was- 
not  bound  to  keep  to  a  heretic.  His  fol- 
lowers believed  that  the  Church  consisted 
only  of  those  predestinated  to  glory,  and. 
that  the  reprobates  were  no  part  of  it ;  that 
the  condemnation  of  the  five  and  forty- 
articles  of  Wiclif  was  wicked  and  unreason- 
able. Moreri  adds  that  they  partly  after- 
wards subdivided,  and  opposed  both  their 
bishops  and  secular  princes  in  Bohemia;, 
where,  if  we  must  take  his  word,  they  were 
the  occasion  of  great  disorders  and  civil 
commotions  in  the  fifteenth  century. — Mil- 
man,  Lat.  Christ,  vol.  vi. ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim, 
ii.  322. 

HUTCHINSONIANS.  "The  name  of 
Hutchinsonians,"  says  Jones  of  Nayland, 
who,  with  Bishops  Home  and  Horsley,  was 
the  most  distinguished  of  those  who  bore 
the  name,  "was  given  to  those  gentlemen- 
who  studied  Hebrew,  and  examuied  the 
writings  of  John  Hutchinson,  Esq.  [bom  at 
Spennythorne,  in  Yorkshire,  1674],  and 
became  inclined  to  favour  his  opinions  in 
theology  and  plulosophy."  The  theological 
opinions  of  these  divines,  so  far  as  thej^ 
were  distinguished  from  those  of  their  own- 
age,  related  chiefly  to  the  explanation  of  the 
doctrine  of  the  Trinity  [see  Note  L.  to  Dr. 
Mill's  five  Sermons  on  the  Temptation  of 
Christ],  and  to  the  maimer  in  which  they 
confirmed  Divine  revelation  generally,  by 
reference  to  the  natural  creation.  The  no- 
tion of  a  Trinity,  it  was  maintained,  was 
taken  from  the  three  agents  in  the  system 
of  nature,  fire,  light,  and  air,  on  which  all 
natural  light  and  motion  depend,  and  which, 
were  said  to  signify  the  three  supreme 
powers  of  the  Godhead  in  the  administra- 
tion of  the  spiritual  world.  This  led  to 
their  opposing  Newton's  theory  of  gravity, 
and  to  their  denying  that  most  matter  is,. 


HYMN 

like  the  mind,  capable  of  active  qualities, 
and  to  their  ascribing  attraction,  repulsion, 
&c.,  to  subtle  causes  not  immaterial.  They 
maintained  that  the  present  condition  of 
the  earth  bears  evident  marks  of  an 
universal  flood-,  and  that  extraneous  fossils 
are  to  be  accounted  for  by  the  same  cata- 
strophe. They  urged  great  precaution  in 
the  study  of  classical  heathen  literature, 
under  the  conviction  that  it  had  tended  to 
produce  pantheistic  notions,  then  so  popular. 
They  also  looked  with  some  suspicion  upon 
■what  is  called  natural  religion,  and  to  many 
passages  of  Scripture  they  gave  a  figurative, 
rather  than  a  literal  interpretation  (See 
Jones's  Life  of  Bishop  Home;  Neale's 
Life  of  Bishop  Tarry). 

HYMN  (Gr.  v^ivos ;  Lat.  hymnus ; 
Eng.  hum).  A  song  of  adoration.  I.  The 
earliest  hymn  on  record  is  that  which 
Moses  and  Miriam  sang  after  the  deliverance 
of  the  children  of  Israel  (Exod.  xv.  1,  21). 
The  Psalms  of  David  were  hymns  to  be  sung 
with  musical  accompaniment  (1  Chron. 
vi.  13;  xxi.  5),  and  very  often  used  anti- 
phonally — the  choirs  answering  one  another 
(See  1  Sam.  xviii.  6).  In  the  Captivity  the 
songs  or  hymns  of  Zion  were  remembered ; 
but  the  faithful  Jews  refused  to  sing  them 
in  a  strange  land  (Ps.  cxxxvii.).  When 
the  Jews  under  Ezra  were  allowed  to  return 
to  Jerusalem,  singing  men  and  singing 
women  accompanied  them  (Ezra  ii.  65 ; 
Neh.  vii.  67) ;  and  at  the  later  re-dedication 
of  the  temple  after  the  desecration  by 
Antiochus  Epiphanes,  hymns  were  sung, 
accompanied  by  "citheras  and  harps  and 
cymbals"  (1  Mace.  iv.  54).  The  Hallel 
group  of  psalms  was  always  sung  at  the 
fea.st  of  Tabernacles,  and  also  at  the  solemn 
paschal  feast;  to  this  custom  reference  is 
made  by  St.  Matthew  (xxvi.  30)  when  he 
speaks  of  our  Lord  and  His  disciples  after 
supper  '•'  singing  a  hymn."  Afterwards  the 
word  hymn  was  not  restricted  to  the  psalms, 
but  implied  any  words  sung,  or  even  rhyth- 
mically recited ;  to  which  St.  Paul  refers 
when  he  bids  the  Colossians  to  teach  and 
admonii-h  one  another  "  in  psalms  and 
hymns  and  spiritual  songs "  (Col.  iii.  16 ; 
see  also  Eph.  v.  19).  Some  commentators 
(e.g.  Grotius  and  Michaelis)  regard  the 
words  in  Acts  iv.  24,  "  Lord,  thou  art 
God,"  &c.,  as  the  first  Christian  hymn,  and 
assert  that  it  can  easily  be  reduced  to 
rhythm.  Such  passages  as  those  in  Eph. 
V.  14,  "  Awake  thou  that  sleepest,"  &c. ;  in 
I  Tim.  iii.  1-16,  in  2  Tim.  ii.  11;  and  in 
many  parts  of  the  Apocalypse,  have  also 
been  supposed  to  be  fragments  of  hymns. 
Pliny  speaks  of  the  "Carmen,"  or  hymn, 
which  the  Christians  were  wont  to  sing  to 
Christ  (^Ep.  Plin.  sec.  ad  Trajan  Imp.) ;  but 
the  words  "  vfuios  "  or  "  vfxvokoyelv  "  do  not 


HYMN 


391 


occur  in  Justin  Martyr,  or  in  the  Apostolic 
Constitutions,  though  the  latter  contains  the 
hymn  "Gloria  in  Excelsis"  (See  Oloria). 
Origen  speaks  of  hymns  to  God  and  Christ 
{Gont.  Cels.  viii.  67),  and  Eusebius  also  refers 
to  them  as  "  cSSai  abcXcpiav  air'  ipx^is  vno 
TTiarav  ypafpfiaai "  (TiT.  ]S.  f.  28). 

It  would  seem,  therefore,  that  hymns 
were  much  used  in  the  second  century,  and 
probably  in  the  first,  although  we  have  not 
the  names  nor  the  composition  of  any  writer 
of  that  early  date  (See  Von  Seelen's  de 
poesia  Christiana  non  a  terfiopost  Christum 
natum  seculo  demum,  sed  a  prima  et  secunda 
deducenda).  St.  Basil  (JDe  Spirit.  Sancto, 
0.  29)  mentions  one  Athenogenus,  a  con- 
temporary of  Clemens  Alexandrinus,  as 
the  author  of  a  doxological  hymn  ;  and  one 
charge  made  against  Paul  of  Samosata  was 
that  "  he  had  put  a  stop  to  the  hymns  that 
were  sung  to  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ,"  for  he 
said  that  they  were  innovations,  the  work  of 
"men  of  modem  times"  (Euseb.  S.  E. 
vii.  30).  By  the  second  Council  of  Antioch, 
A.D.  269,  he  was  condemned ;  but  with 
regard  to  protesting  against  the  multiplying 
of  hymns,  it  would  seem  that  he  had  some 
justification ;  for  the  Council  of  Laodicea, 
some  years  later,  passed  a  canon  prohibiting 
the  use  of  hymns  composed  by  private 
persons,  and  this  was  confirmed  by  the 
Council  of  Chalcedon  a.d.  451.  Clemens 
Alexandrinus  is  the  earliest  Father  in  whose 
works  hymns  are  found,  and  he  was  fol- 
lowed by  Gregory  Nazianzen,  who  died  a.d. 
390,  and  Synesius,  bishop  of  Ptolemais,  who 
was  some  years  later.  St.  Chrysostom  had 
hymns  sung  in  procession  to  counteract  the 
influence  of  the  Arians,  who  had  adopted  a 
similar  course  (Soz.  H.  E.  viii.  5).  These 
hymns  were  probably,  many  of  them  at 
least,  taken  from  the  compositions  of  Ephraim 
of  Edessa,  who  wrote  them  to  counteract 
the  influence  of  the  Greek  songs  and  music 
which  had  been  introduced  by  Bardesanes, 
or  his  son  Harmonius,  and  which  were 
very  popular.  Ephraim  seems  to  have  been 
a  good  choir  trainer,  standing  in  the  midst 
and  leading  his  singers  (Soz.  iv.  16 ;  Au- 
gusti  de  Hymnis  byrorum  Sacris,  1841). 
St.  Chrysostom's  expedient  was  attended 
with  great  success,  and  the  hymn-singing 
was  most  hearty  (See  Neale's  Hymns  of 
the  Eastern  Church,  p.  35 ;  Stephens'  Life 
of  St.  John  Chrysostom,  p.  236,  2nd  ed.). 
But  the  hymns  now  in  use  in  the  Greek 
Church  were  not  introduced  till  the  eighth 
and  ninth  centuries. — Neale,  p.  13. 

II.  In  the  Western  Church  Hilary,  bishop 
of  Poictiers,  who  died  a.d.  368,  is  said  to 
have  been  the  first  who  composed  hymns 
for  public  worship.  He  was  followed  by 
St.  Ambrose,  who  has  been  called  the 
father  of  church  music  in  the  West.     From 


392 


HYMN 


his  time  the  hymns  of  the  Western  Bur- 
jjassed  those  of  the  Eastern  Church.  To 
Ignatius,  the  disciple  and  friend  of  St. 
John,  tradition  attributes  the  introduction 
of  antiphonal  singing  of  psalms,  and  hymns 
at  Antioch  (See.  H.  E.  vi.  8).  From 
Antioch,  it  is  said,  that  Ambrose  gained  his 
musical  and  hymnal  ideas  (See  Ambrosian 
Rite).  However  this  may  be,  there  can  he 
no  doubt  that  he  did  a  great  work,  and 
with  regard  to  his  success  no  stronger  testi- 
mony can  he  given  than  that  of  St.  Augus- 
tine. "  At  that  time,"  the  Father  says,  "  it 
was  instituted,  that  after  the  manner  of 
the  Eastern  Church,  hymns  and  psalms 
should  be  sung,  lest  the  people  should  pine 
away  in  the  tediousness  of  sorrow:  which 
custom,  retained  from  them  till  now,  is 
imitated  by  many ;  yea,  by  almost  all  of 
Thy  congregation  throughout  the  rest  of 
the  world "  (Conf.  bk.  ix.  c.  vU.).  And 
elsewhere  he  speaks  of  the  delight,  mingled 
with  tears,  he  experienced  in  hearing  the 
songs  of  the  Church,  being  moved  "  not  by 
the  singing  oidy,  but  by  what  is  sung, 
when  they  are  sung  with  a  clear  and  skil- 
fully modulated  voice."  He  acknowledges 
the  "great  utility  of  the  custom"  {Conf. 
X.,  xxxiii.).  The  hymns  of  St.  Ambrose  are 
remarkable,  not  only  for  their  beauty,  but 
for  their  correctness,  as  dimetre  Iambics. 

Gregory  the  Great  has  left  hymns  in  the 
same  metre,  and  to  him  has  been  ascribed 
the  "  Veni  Creator  Spiritus,"  though  pro- 
bably it  was,  in  some  part  at  all  events,  the ; 
composition  of  St.  Ambrose.  It  has  been' 
assigned  also  to  Charlemagne,  but  with  Uttle 
or  no  authority.  Prudentius  was  the  most 
prolific  writer  of  hymns  in  the  middle  ages. 
Other  celebrated  hymns  are  the  "  Pange 
Lingua  Gloriosi "  of  the  fifth  century,  and 
the  "  Stabat  Mater  "  and  "  Dies  Ira;,"  the 
first  attributed  to  Jacopone  da  Todi,  and 
the  latter  to  Thoma  di  Celano  in  the  four- 
teenth century.  "As  a  whole  the  hym- 
nology  of  the  Latin  Church  has  a  singularly 
solemn  and  majestic  tone." — MUmaa's  Lot. 
Christ,  vol.  vi.  p.  312. 

III.  In  the  Prayer  Book  of  the  Church  of 
England  certain  hymns  are  ordered  to  be 
sung,  as  (i.)  those  from  Holy  Scripture — 
the  "  Magnificat,"  "  Nunc  Dimittis,"  "Bene- 
dictus,"  and  "  Benedioite  "  ;  (ii.)  those  from 
very  ancient  sources,  as  the  "  Te  Deum " 
and  "  Gloria  in  Exoelsis  " ;  (iii.)  the  "  Veni 
Creator  Spiritus "  in  the  Ordinal  But 
other  hymns  have  always  been  used.  Bede 
composed  hymns,  and  successful  vernacular 
translations  of  tlie  Latin  hymns  were  made 
at  an  early  date.  "  It  cannot  be  doubted," 
says  Mr.  Maskell,  "  that  St.  Augustine  in- 
troduced the  hymnal  then  used  at  Eome. 
There  have  been  many  collections  made,  not 
only  of  the   more  ancient  hymns,  but  of 


HYDEOPAEASTATiS 

those  which  were  composed  by  pious  mem- 
bers and  fathers  of  the  Church  in  succeeding 
ages."  At  a  synod  held  at  Exeter,  under 
Bishop  Quivil,  a.d.  1287,  among  other  books 
to  he  provided  was  a  "  Ympnare,"  or,  as  it 
was  commonly  called  in  later  times,  the 
"  Hymnarium,"  or  "  Hymnal " ;  and  great 
care  was  taken  in  arranging  the  music 
(Maskell,  Mon.  Sit,  Ecc.  Ang.  i.,  cviii.). 
Cranmer,  whose  letter  on  church  music  is 
well  known,  was  anxious  to  retain  the  old 
hymns,  and  set  to  work  himself  to  translate 
them ;  but  he  was  not  poetical,  and  found 
himself  unequal  to  the  task.  As  there  was 
no  authorised  hymnal,  it  is  difficult  to  say 
when  the  practice  of  popular  hymn-singing 
estahHshed  itself  in  connexion  with  the 
revised  ritual;  but  such  singing  was  cer- 
tainly in  use  very  early  in  Elizabeth's  reign. 
By  a  royal  Injunction  in  the  year  1559,  it 
was  ordained  that  "for  the  comforting  of 
such  as  delight  in  musick,  it  may  be  per- 
mitted, that  in  the  beginning,  or  the  end 
of  Common  Prayer,  either  at  morning  or 
evening,  there  may  be  sung  an  hymn,  or 
such  like  song  to  the  praise  of  Almighty 
God."  Prom  this  came  the  rubric  "  In 
choirs  and  places  where  they  sing,  here 
foUoweth  the  anthem" — the  word  "an- 
them" implying  also  a  metrical  psalm  or 
hymn  (See  Anthem).  But  though,  accor- 
dins  to  the  rubric,  this  is  the  only  place 
where  a  hymn  is  definitely  authorised,  cus- 
tom has  sanctioned  a  much  freer  interpre- 
tation of  the  rubric  than  its  words  actually 
imply.  And  so  while  the  anthem  retains 
its  place,  "  as  a  first  fruits  of  sacred  musical 
skill  and  science,"  additional  hymns,  in 
other  parts  of  the  service,  are  not  excluded ; 
and  indeed  are  useful  and  delightful  means 
of  quickening  the  religious  feelings  of  the 
congregation. 

IV.  With  regard  to  the  hymns  now  in 
use,  it  is  impossible  to  give  an  account  in  a 
limited  space.  Many  hjonnals  have  in  late 
years  been  published,  superseding  the  stilted 
metrical  versions  of  the  psalms,  by  Stemhold 
and  Hopkins,  and  by  Brady  and  Tate,  &c. 
Such  collections  as  "  Hymns  Ancient  and 
Modem,"  the  "Hymnal  Noted,"  the  "Church 
Hymnal,"  "The  Hymnaiy,"  &c.,  give  a, 
choice  which  must  satisfy  every  one.  An 
exhaustive  account  of  hymns  and  hymn- 
composers,  by  the  Rev.  John  Julian,  has 
lately  been  published  by  Mr.  Murray.  It 
is  entitled  "  A  Dictionary  of  Hymnology." — 
Bingham,  bk.  xiiL,  v.;  Bates,  Christ.  Ant. 
pt.  i.,  xiii.;  Blunt,  Diet.  Doct.  Theol.  317; 
Dr.  Dykes  in  Annot.  P.  B.  Ixiii. ;  Thesaurus 
Hymnologicus  (Daniel);  Hymni  Eecl.  Cas- 
sander,  pp.  149,  301 ;  Neale,  Hymni  Ecd. ; 
Smith's  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.    [H.] 

HYDEOPARASTATiE.  Presenters  of 
water ;  from  their  using  water  only  in  the 


HYPAPANTE 

Eucharist.  Irenaaus  speaks  of  the  Ebionites 
as  rejecting  the  commixture  of  wine  (^Heer. 
-y.  1),  and  St.  Cyprian  says  "  water  caimot 
he  offered  alone"  {Ep.  ad  CsecU.).  Many 
of  the  early  Fathers  also  speak  against  this 
heresy  (Clem.  Alex.  Strom,  i.  19;  Chrys. 
Horn,  m  Matt  Ixxxii.).  The  name  was 
adopted  amongst  others  by  the  Manich- 
Jcans. — Stubbs'  Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  196, 
374. 

HYPAPANTE.  The  Greek  name  for 
the  Purification  of  the  Virgin,  or  Candlemas 
Day. 

HYPERDULIA  (See  Dulia  and  Ido- 
latry). 

HYPOSTASIS.  A  philosophical  and 
theological  Christian  term,  used  originally 
^  imply  a  real  personal  subsistence,  as  in 
the  Epistle  to  the  Hebrews  (i.  3),  where  the 
word  is  translated  in  the  Authorized  Version 
as  "  Person,"  but  in  the  Bevised  Version  the 
■"  substance."  The  Greeks  took  it  in  the  first 
■three  centuries  ior  particular  substance,  and 
therefore  said  there  were  three  hypostases, 
that  is,  three  "Persons,"  according  to  the 
Latins.  Where  some  of  the  Eastern  people 
understanding  the  word  hypostasis  in  another 
sense,  would  not  call  the  Persons  three 
■hypostases,  Athanasius  showed  them,  in  a 
council  held  at  Alexandria  in  362,  that 
they  all  said  the  same  thing,  and  that  all 
the  difference  was,  that  they  gave  to  the 
same  word  two  different  significations :  and 
thus  he  reconciled  them  together.  It  is 
■evident  that  the  word  hypostasis  signifies 
two  things :  first,  an  individual  particular 
substance;  secondly,  a  common  nature  or 
essence.  Now  when  the  Fathers  say  there 
are  "  three  hypostases,"  their  meaning  is 
to  be  judged  from  the  time  they  lived  in ; 
if  it  be  one  of  the  three  first  centuries, 
they  meant  all  along  three  distinct  agents, 
of  which  the  Father  was  supreme.  If 
■one  of  much  later  date  uses  the  expres- 
sion, he  means  most  probably,  little  more 
than  a  mode  of  existence  in  a  common 
jnature. 

HYPOSTATICAL  UNION.  The  union 
of  the  human  nature  of  our  Lord  with 
the  Divine ;  constituting  two  natures  in 
one  person,  and  not  two  persons  in  one 
natm-e,  as  the  Nestorians  assert  (See 
Union). 

HYPOTHETICAL.  This  term  is  some- 
times used  in  relation  to  a  baptism  ad- 
ministered to  a  child,  of  whom  it  is  un- 
certain whether  he  has  been  already  bap- 
tized or  not.  ITie  rubric  states,  that  "if 
they  who  bring  the  infant  to  the  church 
■do  make  such  uncertain  answers  to  the 
priest's  questions,  as  that  it  cannot  appear 
that  the  child  was  baptized  with  water,  in 
the  name  of  the  Father,  and  of  the  Son, 
■and  of  the  Holy  Ghost,"  then  the  priest, 


ICONOCLASTS 


393 


on  performing  the  baptism,  is  to  use  this 
form    of  words,    viz.    "  If   thou    art    not 

already  baptized,  N ,  I  baptize  thee  in 

the  name,"  &c. 

This,  therefore,  is  called  an  hypothetical 
or  conditional  form,  being  used  only  on  the 
supposition  that  the  child  may  not  have 
already  received  baptism. 

HYPSISTARIANS.  Heretics  in  the 
fourth  century  of  Christianity.  According 
to  Gregory  Kazianzen  (whose  own  father 
had  once  been  a  member  of  the  sect,  but 
afterwards  became  a  Christian  bishop),  they 
made  a  mixture  of  the  Jewish  religion  and 
paganism,  for  they  worshipped  fire  with 
the  pagans,  and  observed  the  Sabbath,  and 
legal  abstinence  from  meats,  with  the  Jews. 
— Orat.  xviii.  5. 


I. 

ICONOCLASTS,  or  IMAGE  BREAK- 
ERS (See  Images,  Image  Worship,  and 
Idolatry).  From  eixwv,  an  image,  and  icXdo), 
to  break.  A  name  given  to  those  who  op- 
posed the  veneration  of  images  in  the  eighth 
century.  Sarantapechs,  or  Serantampicus, 
a  Jew,  persuaded  Ezidus,  or  Oizidus,  king 
of  the  Arabs,  to  take  the  images  of  saints 
out  of  churches  that  belonged  to  the 
Christians :  and  some  time  after,  Bazere 
[but  liaronius  writes  Beser'\,  becommg  a 
Mahometan  in  Syria,  where  he  was  a  slave, 
insinuated  himself  so  much  into  the  favour 
of  Leo  Isauricus,  that  this  emperor,  at  Ms 
persuasion  and  that  of  other  Jews,  who  had 
foretold  to  him  his  coming  to  the  empire,  de- 
clared against  images,  about  a.d.  726,  ordered 
the  statue  of  Christ,  placed  over  one  of  the 
gates  of  the  palace,  to  be  thrown  down  a.d. 
730,  and  being  enraged  at  a  tumult  oc- 
casioned thereby,  issued  a  proclamation 
wherein  he  abolished  the  use  of  statues, 
and  menaced  the  worshippeis  with  severe 
punishments;  and  all  the  sohcitations  of 
Germanus  the  patriarch,  and  of  the  bishop 
of  Rome,  could  prevail  nothing  in  their 
favour.  His  son  and  successor,  Constantine, 
assembled  a  council  a.d.  754,  which  decreed 
the  removal  of  images  and  religious  pictures 
from  church-walls.  The  council  was  con- 
demned at  Rome,  but  the  emperor  strove 
more  than  ever  to  gain  his  point,  exacting 
an  oath  against  image-worship  from  all  his 
subjects,  and  treating  those  who  resisted 
with  great  cruelty.  Leo  IV.  succeeded  in  775, 
and  reigned  but  four  years,  leaving  his  son 
Constantine  under  the  tutelage  of  the  emjjress 
Irene.  In  her  time,  a.d.  787,  was  held  the 
second  Council  of  Nice,  in  which  a  decree 


394 


IDES 


was  passed  that  the  image  of  Christ  and  of 
the  saints  should  be  restored  for  reverence 
(npoa-Kvvrjcrts)  but  not  for  worship  (KaTpeia). 
This  decision  was  confirmed  by  the  Pope : 
but  was  less  favourably  received  north  of 
the  Alps.  Charles  the  Great  submitted  this 
and  other  acts  of  the  Council  to  the  learned 
Alcuin,  who  pronounced  against  them  in  a 
long  treatise  called  "  The  Caroline  Books." 
The  Council  of  Frankfort,  a.d.  794,  which 
was  a  Diet  of  the  Empire  as  well  as  an 
ecclesiiistical  synod,  confirmed  his  judg- 
ment, in  opposition  to  that  of  Pope  Adrian  I. 
The  controversy  on  this  subject  lasted  in  both 
the  Eastern  and  Western  Church  through 
part  of  the  following  century.  Ultimately 
the  Eastern  Church  restricted  the  veneration 
of  visible  forms  to  paintings  or  mosaics  on 
flat  surfaces,  while  the  Western  Church, 
including  the  Erankish  branch,  permitted 
the  use  of  sculptured  images  also. — Eobert- 
son,  Ch.  Hist.  vol.  ii.  part  i. ;  Milman's  Lat. 
Christianity,  book  iv.  c.  7  ;  Gieseler,  ii. ; 
Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  510.     [H.] 

IDES.  A  word  continued  in  the  Roman 
calendar  from  the  old  Pagan  one,  and  in- 
serted in  all  old  editions  of  the  Prayer 
Book.  The  ides  were  eight  days  in  each 
month :  in  March,  May,  July,  and  Octo- 
ber, the  ides  ended  on  the  15th,  and  in 
all  other  months  on  the  13th  day.  The 
word  Ides,  taken  from  the  Greek  (c'Sor), 
means  an  aspect  or  appearance,  and  was 
primarily  used  to  denote  the  full  moon. 
The  system  of  the  original  Eoman  calendar 
was  founded  on  the  change  of  the  moon,  the 
nones  being  the  completion  of  the  first 
quarter,  as  the  ides  were  of  the  second. 
But  they  could  not  really  follow  the  moon. — 
Stephens,  Book  of  Oommon  Prayer ;  Notes 
on  the  Calendar. 

IDIOTM  (ISwrm).  Literally,  private 
persons ;  but  the  word  was  used  by  the  early 
Eathers  to  imply  laymen  as  distinct  from 
those  ordained  (xX^poi).  St.  Chrysostom 
{Horn.  35  in  1  Cor.  xiv.)  says  that  the  word 
there  used  by  the  Apostle,  which  we  trauslate 
"  unlearned,"  signifies  no  more  than  a  lay- 
man.— Bingham,  i.  5.     [H.] 

IDOLATRY  (fiSaXoi/,  an  image,  and 
\aTpda,  worship).  The  superstitious  wor- 
ship paid  to  idols  (See  Images;  Image- 
Worship  ;  Iconoclast). 

ILE  (See  Aisle). 

ILLUMINATI(0fflrifd/x6vot).  Those  who 
were  newly  baptized  were  so  called  {Gone. 
Laod.  Can.  3) ;  "  their  understandings," 
says  Justin  Martyr,  "  being  enlightened  by 
the  knowledge  consequent  on  baptism " 
(Apol.  ii.;  cf.  Heb.  vi.  4;  x.  32).     [H.] 

ILLUMINATI,  or  ALLUMBRADOS. 
Certain  Spanish  heretics  who  began  to 
appear  in  the  world  about  1575;  but  the 
authors  being  severely  punished,  this  sect 


IJIAGES 

was  stifled,  as  it  were,  until  1623,  and  then 
awakened  with  more  vigour  in  the  diocese 
of  Seville.  The  edict  against  them  specifies 
seventy-six  different  errors,  whereof  the 
principal  are,  that  with  the  assistance  of 
mental  prayer  and  imion  with  God  (which 
they  boasted  of),  they  were  in  such  a  state 
of  perfection  as  not  to  need  either  good 
works,  or  the  sacraments  of  the  Church. 
Soon  after  these  were  suppressed,  a  new 
sect,  under  the  same  name,  appeared  in 
France.  These,  too,  were  entirely  ex- 
tinguished in  the  year  1635.  Among  other 
extravagances,  they  held  that  friar  Anthony 
Bocquet  had  a  system  of  belief  and  practice 
revealed  to  him  which  exceeded  all  that 
was  in  Christianity  ;  that  by  virtue  of  that 
method,  people  might  improve  to  the  same 
degree  of  perfection  that  saints  and  the 
Virgin  Mai-y  had ;  far  above  St.  Peter  and 
St.  PauL 

In  1776,  an  order  of  lUuminati,  or 
Perfeotibilists,  was  started  in  Germany  under 
Weishaupt,  a  professor  of  Canon  Law.  It 
was  suppressed  by  the  Elector  of  Bohemia 
in  1785,  but  its  influence  had  spread  widely, 
and  was  very  pernicious. 

IMAGES.  In  the  religious  sense  of  the- 
word,  there  appears  to  have  been  little  or  no- 
use  of  images  in  the  Christian  Church  for  the 
first  three  or  four  hundred  years,  as  may  be 
gathered  from  the  silence  of  all  ancient 
authors,  and  of  the  heathens  themselves, 
who  never  recriminated,  or  charged  the 
use  of  images  on  the  primitive  Christians. 
There  are  positive  proofs  in  the  fourth 
century  that  the  use  of  images  was  not 
allowed;  particularly,  the  Council  of  Eliberis 
decrees  that  pictures  ought  not  to  be  put  in 
churches,  lest  that  which  is  worshipped  lie 
painted  upon  the  walls  (Can.  xxxvi.). 
Petavius  gives  this  general  reason  for  the  pro- 
hibition of  all  images  whatever  at  that  time 
• — that  the  remembrance  of  idolatry  was  yet 
fresh  in  men's  minds.  About  the  latter  end 
of  the  fourth  centur}',  pictures  of  saints  and 
martyrs  began  to  creep  into  the  churches. 
Paulinus,  bishop  of  Nola,  ordered  his  church 
to  be  painted  with  Scripture  histories,  such 
as  those  of  Esther,  Job,  Tobit,  and  Judith. 
And  St.  Augustine  often  speaks  of  the 
pictures  of  Abraham  offering  his  son  Isaac, 
and  those  of  St.  Peter  and  St.  Paul,  but 
vfithout  approving  the  use  of  them ;  on  the 
contrary,  he  teUs  us  the  Church  condemned 
such  as  paid  a  religious  veneration  to 
pictures,  and  daily  endeavoured  to  correct 
them,  as  untoward  children. 

It  was  not  till  after  the  second  Council  of 
Nice,  A.D.  787,  that  images  of  the  Deity,  or 
the  Trinity,  were  allowed  in  churches.  Pope 
Gregory  II.,  in  the  epistle  which  he  wrote  to 
the  emperor  Leo  to  defend  the  worship  of 
images  generally,  denies  it  to  be  lawful  to 


IMAGE  WOESHIP 

make  any  representation  of  the  Deit}'.  Nor 
(lid  the  ancient  Christians  approve  of  massive 
images,  or  statues  of  wood,  metal,  or  stone, 
but  only  pictures  or  paintings  to  be  used  in 
chiu-ches,  and  those  symbolical  rather  than 
any  other.  Thus  a  lamb  was  the  symbol  of 
Jesus  Christ,  and  a  dove  of  the  Holy  Ghost. 
But  the  sixth  general  council  forbade  the 
picturing  Christ  any  more  under  the  figure 
of  a  lamb,  and  ordered  that  he  should  be 
represented  by  the  effigy  of  a  man.  By 
this  time,  it  is  presumed,  the  worship  of 
images  was  begun,  anno  692. 

By  a  decree  of  the  Council  of  Trent,  it  is 
forbidden  to  set  up  any  extraordinary  and 
unusual  image  in  the  churches  without  the 
bishop's  approbation  first  obtained.  As  to 
the  consecration  of  images,  they  proceed  in 
the  same  manner  as  at  the  benediction  of  a 
new  cross.  At  saying  the  prayer,  the  saint, 
whom  the  image  represents,  is  named :  alter 
which  the  priest  sprinkles  the  image  with 
holy  water.  But  when  an  image  of  the 
Virgin  Mary  is  to  be  blessed,  it  is  thrice 
incensed,  besides  being  thrice  sprinkled,  vrith 
other  ceremonious  observances. 

[The  law  about  the  lawfulness  of  images 
in  our  Church  has  been  settled  by  the 
Exeter  reredos  case  (JPhilljpotts  v.  Boyd, 
L.  R.  6  P.  C,  and  Iliighes  v.  Edwards, 
2  Prob.  Div.).  In  both  of  them  it  was 
decided  that  the  test  of  the  lawfulness  of 
images  is  whether  they  are  of  such  a 
character  as  may  lead  to  idolatry ;  and 
consequently,  that  an  artistic  group  of 
images,  even  if  representing  the  whole  of 
the  crucifixion  as  a  general  picture,  is 
lawful,  while  a  single  crucifix  is  not,  as  has 
been  several  times  decided,  and  last  by  P.  0. 
in  Ridsdale  v.  Clifton,  2  Prob.  Div.  304. 
It  is  unnecessary  here  to  go  through  the 
several  Acts  against  images  (2  &  3  Ed.  VI. 
c.  6,  and  1  Jac.  c.  25),  which  are  fully  set 
forth  and  explained  in  those  judgments. 
The  result  is  that  the  Act  of  Edward  VI.  is 
stUl  in  force  against  them,  though  in  other 
respects  that  of  James  is  repealed  by  26  & 
27  Vict.  c.  125.]     [G.] 

IMAGE  WORSHIP.  The  worship  of 
images  occasioned  great  contests  both  in 
the  Eastern  and  Western  Chruches  (See 
Iconoclasts).  Nicephorus,  who  had  wrested 
the  empire  from  Irene,  in  the  year  802,  main- 
tained the  worship  of  images.  The  emperor 
Leo  V.  (the  Armenian)in  813  declared  against 
the  worship  of  images,  and  expelled  Nice- 
phorus, patriarch  of  Constantinople,  Theo- 
dorus  Studita,  Nicetas,  and  others,  who  had 
asserted  it.  Michael  11. ,  desiring  to  re- 
establish peace  in  the  East,  proposed  to 
assemble  a  council,  to  which  both  the 
Iconoclasts  (those  who  broke  down  images) 
and  the  advocates  of  image  worship  should 
be  admitted ;  but  the  latter  refusing  to  sit 


IMAGE  WORSHIP 


395 


with  heretics,  as  they  called  the  Iconoclasts, 
the  emperor  found  out  a  medium.  He  left 
all  men  free  to  worship  or  not  worsnip 
images,  and  published  a  regulation,  for- 
bidding the  taking  of  crosses  out  of  the 
churches,  to  put  images  in  their  place ;  the 
paying  of  adoration  to  the  images  them- 
selves ;  the  clothing  of  statues ;  the  making 
them  godfathers  and  godmothers  to  chil- 
dren ;  the  lighting  candles  before  them,  and 
oifering  incense  to  them,  &c.  Michael  sent 
ambassadors  into  the  West  to  get  this  regu- 
lation approved.  These  ministers  applied 
themselves  to  Louis  le  Debonnaire,  who 
sent  an  embassy  to  Eome  upon  this  subject. 
But  the  Romans,  and  Pope  Paschal  I.,  did 
not  admit  of  the  regulation ;  and  a  synod, 
held  at  Paris  in  824,  was  of  opinion,  that 
although  the  use  of  images  ought  not  to  be 
prohibited,  yet  it  was  not  allowable  to  pay 
them  any  religious  worship.  At  length  the 
emperor  Michael  settled  his  regulation  in. 
the  East;  and  his  son  Theophilus,  who 
succeeded  him  in  the  j'ear  829,  held  a 
counoU  at  Constantinople,  in  which  the 
Iconoclasts  were  condemned,  and  the  worship 
of  images,  but  only  in  the  form  of  paintings 
or  mosaics,  restored.  The  French  and  Ger- 
mans used  themselves,  by  degrees,  to  pay  an. 
outward  honour  to  images,  and  conformed  to 
the  Church  of  Rome. 

All  the  points  of  doctrine  or  practice  in 
which  the  Church  of  Rome  differs  from  the 
Church  of  England  ai-e  novelties,  introduced 
gradually  in  the  middle  ages  :  of  these  the 
worship  of  images  is  the  earliest  practice, 
which  received  the  sanction  of  what  the 
Papists  call  a  general  council,  though  the 
second  Council  of  Nice,  a.d.  787,  was,  in 
fact,  no  general  council.  As  this  is 
the  earliest  authority  for  any  of  the 
Roman  peculiarities,  and  as  the  Church  of 
England  at  that  early  period  was  remarkably 
concerned  in  resisting  the  novelty,  it  may  nob 
be  out  of  place  to  mention  the  circumstances. 
The  emperor  Charles  the  Great,  who  was 
very  much  offended  at  the  decrees  of  this 
council  in  favour  of  images,  sent  a  copy 
of  them  into  England.  Alcuin,  a  most 
learned  member  of  the  Church  of  England, 
attacked  them,  and  having  produced  Scrip- 
tural authority  against  them,  transmitted, 
the  same  to  Charles  in  the  name  of  the 
bishops  of  the  Church  of  England.  Roger 
of  Hoveden,  Simeon  of  Durham,  and  the 
so-called  Matthew  of  Westminster,  men- 
tion the  fact,  and  speak  of  the  worship  of 
images  as  being  execrated  by  the  whole 
Church.  The  emperor,  pursuing  his  hostility 
to  the  Nicene  Council,  published  four  books 
against  it  composed  by  Alcuin,  and  trans- 
mitted them  to  the  Pope  Adrian  I.;  who 
replied  to  them  in  an  epistle  "  concerning 
images,  against  those  who  impugn  the  Nicene 


.396        IMMAOULATB  CONCEPTION 

Synod,"  as  the  title  is  given,  together  with 
the  epistle  itself,  in  the  seventh  volume  of 
Labbe  and  Cossart's  Councils.  The  ge- 
nuineness of  these  books  is  admitted  by  all 
the  chief  Roman  writers.  For  the  purpose 
of  considering  the  subject  more  fully, 
•Charles  assembled  a  great  council  of  British, 
<jallican,  German,  and  Italian  bishops  at 
Praukfort,  a.d.  794,  at  which  two  legates 
from  the  bishop  of  Eome  were  present; 
where,  after  mature  deliberation,  the  de- 
crees of  the  so-called  general  Council  of 
JSTice,  notwithstanding  Pope  Adrian's  coun- 
tenance, were  " rejected"  "  despised,'"  and 
"  conderaned."  The  synod  at  Frankfort  re- 
mains a  monument  of  a  noble  stand  in  de- 
fence of  the  ancient  religion,  in  which  the 
•Church  of  England  had  an  honourable 
share,  occupying,  a  thousand  years  ago,  the 
self-same  ground  we  now  maintain,  of  pro- 
testing against  Roman  corruptions  of  the 
•Catholic  faith. 

At  the  time  of  the  Reformation  errors  in 
■doctrine  and  practice  prevailed  mth  regard 
to  image  worship,  and  were  upheld  by  many 
Romanist  writers.  "  Eundem  honorem  deberi 
imagini,  et  exemplari ;  ac  proinde  imagines 
Sanctaj  Trinitatis,  Christi,  et  Crucis  cultu 
latriaj  adorandas  esse."  Thus  Jeremy  Tay- 
lor quotes  Almain — "the  images  of  the 
Trinity,  of  Christ,  and  of  the  Cross,  are 
to  be  adored  with  divine  worship."  Bishop 
Taylor  also  mentions  many  others  as  up- 
holding this  opinion;  amongst  them 
Aquinas,  Bonaventure,  Cajetan,  &c.  And 
though  much  caution  was  used  in  the  ex- 
pression, "  it  is  plain  that  the  Council  of 
Trent  intended  such  honour  and  worship  to 
be  due "  (See  Taylor's  Works,  vol.  xiii. 
pp.  385  seq.,  Heber's  Ed. :  where  the  matter 
is  exhaustively  treated).  In  England  one 
of  the  earliest  works  of  the  Reformation 
•was  to  get  rid  of  this  superstition,  and  all 
images,  "abused  by  pilgrimages  and  other 
vspecial  honours,"  were  to  be  removed  (Jn- 
junctioiis  of  the  King's  Vicegerent ;  Burnet's 
Hist.  Ref.  vol.  i. ;  Records,  p.  276).  All  such 
worship  is  prohibited  by  the  "  Institution 
of  a  Christian  Man"  (p.  137).  In  Edward 
VI.'s  reign  all  images  were  removed  by  order 
of  Council  (Burnet,  vol.  ii.  p.  111),  and 
in  this  the  Church  acquiesced  "under  the 
conviction  that  they  were  unnecessary  to 
true  piety,  and  liable  to  the  grossest  abuses." 
— Pahner's  Hist,  of  Church,  i.  386,  &c. 

The  article  22  condemning  "  worshipping 
of  images  and  reliques,"  was  written  in 
1553,  and  adopted  in  1562.  "While  any- 
thing approaching  image  worship  is  sternly 
prohibited,  the  Church  of  England  allows 
the  use  of  images  in  the  manner  stated  in 
the  preceding  article  (See  Images').     FH 1 

IMMACULATE  CONCEPTION  (See 
•Conctption,  Immaculate). 


IMPLICIT  FAITH 

IMMERSION.  The  primitive  mode  of 
adrnkustering  the  sacrament  of  baptism,  by 
which  the  person  baptized  was  thrice 
jilunged  into  the  water.  "  Immersion  seems, 
from  the  Anglo  Saxon  time  down  to  the 
middle  of  the  16th  century,  to  have  been 
always  the  rule  in  the  Church  of  England  " 
(Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  i.  24,  and  ccxlvii.).  Im- 
mersion is  the  mode  of  baptisiag  first  pre- 
scribed in  our  ofHce  of  public  baptism;  but 
it  is  permitted  to  pour  water  upon  the  child, 
if  the  godfathers  and  godmothers  certify 
that  the  child  is  weak  (See  Affusion; 
Baptism ;  Aspersion). 

IMPANATION.  A  term  (like  transub- 
stantiation  and  consubstantiation)  used  to 
designate  a  false  notion  of  the  manner  of 
the  presence  of  the  body  and  blood  of  our 
Blessed  Lord  in  the  holy  Eucharist. 

This  word  is  formed  from  the  Latin  panis 
(bread),  and  signifies  the  Divine  person 
Jesus  Christ,  God  and  man,  becoming 
}iread  \and  wine],  or  taking  the  nature  of 
bread,  for  the  purposes  of  the  Holy  Eucha- 
rist :  so  that,  as  in  the  one  Divine  person 
Jesus  Christ  there  are  two  perfect  na- 
tures, God  and  man;  so  in  the  eucharistic 
elements,  according  to  the  doctrine  ex- 
pressed by  the  word  impanation,  there  are 
two  perfect  natures — one  of  the  Divine  Son 
of  the  Blessed  Virgin,  and  another  of  the 
eucharistic  elements :  the  two  natures  being 
one,  not  in  a  figurative,  but  in  a  real  and 
literal  sense,  by  a  kind  of  hypostatical 
union. 

The  nearest  approach  to  the  doctrine  of 
impanation  avowed  by  any  sect,  is  that  of 
the  Lutherans  (See  Consubstantiation). 

IMPLICIT  FAITH.  The  faith  which 
is  given  without  reserve  or  examination, 
such  as  the  Church  of  Rome  requires  of  her 
members.  The  reliance  we  have  on  the 
Church  of  England  is  grounded  on  the  fact, 
that  she  undertakes  to  prove  that  all  her 
doctrines  are  Scriptural,  but  the  Church  of 
Rome  requires  credence  on  her  own  au- 
thority. The  Church  of  England  places 
the  Bible  as  an  authority  equal  with  the 
Church,  the  Church  of  Rome  makes  the 
authority  of  the  Church  above  that  of  the 
Bible.  The  Roman  divines  teach  that  we 
are  to  observe,  not  how  the  Church  proves 
anything,  but  what  she  says :  that  the  will 
of  God  is,  that  we  should  believe  and  con- 
fide in  his  ministers  in  the  same  manner  as 
himself.  Cardinal  Toletus,  in  his  instruc- 
tions for  priests,  asserts,  "  that  if  a  rustic 
believes  his  bishop  proposing  an  heretical 
tenet  for  an  article  of  faith,  such  behef  is 
meritorious."  Cardinal  Cusanus  tells  lis, 
"  That  irrational  obedience  is  the  most  con- 
summate and  perfect  obedience,  when  we 
obey  without  attending  to  reason,  as  a  beast 
obeys  his  driver."     In  an  ex^istle   to   the 


IMPOSITION 

Boliemians  he  has  these  words  :  "  I  assert 
that  there  are  no  precepts  of  Christ  hut 
those  which  are  received  as  such  by  the 
Church  (meaning  the  Church  of  Eome). 
When  the  Church  changes  her  judgment, 
God  changes  his  judgment  liltewise." 

IMPOSITION  or  LAYING  ON  OF 
HANDS.  St.  Paul,  or  the  writer  of  the 
Epistle  to  the  Hebrews  (Heb.  vi.  2),  speaks 
of  the  doctrine  of  laying  on  of  hands  as  one 
of  the  fundamentals  of  Christianity  :  it  is 
an  ecclesiastical  action,  by  which  a  blessing 
is  conveyed  from  God  through  his  minister 
to  a  person  prepared  by  repentance  and  faith 
to  receive  it.  It  is  one  of  the  most  ancient 
forms  in  the  world,  sanctioned  by  the 
practice  of  Jacob,  Moses,  the  Apostles,  and 
oiu-  Blessed  Lord  Himself.  The  imposition 
of  hands  undoubtedly  took  its  rise  from 
the  practice  of  the  JctosIi  Church,  in  ini- 
tiating persons  for  performing  any  sacred 
ofBce,  or  conferring  any  employ  of  dignity 
or  power.  Thus  Joshua  was  consecrated 
to  Ms  high  office  (Numb,  xxvii.  23). 
Hence  the  Jews  derived  their  custom  of 
ordaining  their  rabbis  by  imposition  of 
hands. 

In  the  early  Church  the  ceremony  was 
iised  in  benediction,  absolution,  and  unction 
of  the  sick,  as  well  as  in  confirmation  and 
ordination.  But  probably  the  xf^podea-la  men- 
tioned by  St.  Chrysostom  {Horn.  52)  at  the 
benediction,  implied  only  the  raising  of  the 
hands  of  the  bishop  over  the  congregation ;. 
and  the  imposition  of  hands  seems  only  to 
have  been  considered  necessary  in  the  two 
cases  of  confirmation  and  ordination.  With 
regard  to  the  foi-mer  all  the  early  Fathers 
deemed  it  essential,  as  based  upon  Scriptural 
teaching.  (St.  Cyprian,  JEp.  72, 73 ;  Jerom. 
emit.  Lucifer,  cap.  iv. ;  Aug.  de  Bapt.  lib.  3. 
cap.  16,  &c. :  see  Confirmation).  And  in 
respect  of  the  latter  this  ceremony  has  been 
always  esteemed  so  essential  a  part  of  ordi- 
nation, that  any  other  way  of  conferring 
orders  without  it  has  been  judged  invalid. 
We  find  it  used  by  the  Apostles  as  often  as 
they  admitted  any  new  members  into  the 
ministry  of  the  Church.  For,  when  they 
ordained  the  first  deacons,  it  is  recorded,  that 
after  praying  "  they  laid  hands  on  them  " 
(Acts  vi.  6).  At  the  ordination  of  Barnabas 
and  Paul  it  is  said  that  they  "  fasted  and 
prayed  and  laid  their  hands  on-  them" 
Acts  xiii.  3).  When  St.  Paul  bids  Timothy 
have  regard  to  the  graces  conferred  in  his 
ordination,  he  observes  that  these  were 
conferred  by  imposition  of  hands :  "  Neglect 
not  the  gift  that  is  in  thee,  which  was  given 
thee  by  prophecy,  with  the  laying  on  of 
the  hands  of  the  presbytery"  (1  Tim.  iv. 
14).  And  in  his  other  Epistle  he  exhorts 
him  to  "  stir  up  the  gift  of  God  which  was 
in  him  by  the  putting  on  of  his  hands " 


INCARNATION 


SOT 


(2  Tim.  i.  0).  The  primitive  Christians, 
following  exactly  after  this  copy,  never 
admitted  any  into  orders  hut  with  this 
ceremony :  so  that  the  ancient  councils 
seldom  use  any  other  word  for  ordination 
than  "imjMsition  of  hands"  {Cone.  Chalced. 
0.  15 ;  Trullo,  cc.  14, 40  ;  Constit.  Apost.  viii. 
19) ;  and  the  ancient  writers  of  the  Church 
signify,  that  the  clerical  character,  and  the 
gifts  of  the  Spirit,  were  confeiTred  by  this 
action. 

It  must  he  observed  here,  that  the  im- 
position of  the  bishop's  hands  alone  is  re- 
quired in  the  ordination  of  a  deacon,  in 
conformity  to  the  usage  of  the  ancient 
Church.  But  priests  concur  in  the  ordination 
of  a  priest. — Dr.  Nicholls,  Cone.  Nic.  c.  19. 

This  was  in  the  early  Church  a  distinction 
between  the  three  superior  and  five  inferior 
orders,  that  the  first  were  given  by  imposition 
of  hands,  and  the  second  were  not. 

IMPEOPEIATION.  Ecclesiastical  pro- 
perty, the  profits  of  which  are  in  the  hands 
of  a  layman :  thus  distinguished  from 
appropriation,  which  is  when  the  profits  of 
a  benefice  are  in  the  hands  of  a  college,  &c. 
Impropriations  have  arisen  from  the  con- 
fiscation of  monasteries  in  the  time  of 
Heniy  VHI.,  when,  instead  of  restoring  the- 
tithes  to  ecclesiastical  uses,  they  were  given 
or  sold  to  laymen. 

IMPUTATION.  The  attributing  a  cha- 
racter to  a  person  which  he  does  not  really 
possess ;  thus,  when  in  baptism  we  are 
justified,  the  righteousness  is  imputed, 
as  well  as  imparted  to  us.  The  imputation 
which  respects  our  justification  before  God, 
is  God's  gracious  reckoning  of  the  righteous- 
ness of  Christ  to  believers,  and  his  accept- 
ance of  these  persons  as  righteous  on  that 
account ;  then  sins  being  imputed  to  him, 
and  his  obedience  being  imputed  to  them. 
Eom.  iv.  6,  7 ;  v.  18,  19  ;  2  Cor.  v.  21 
(See  Faith  and  Justification). 

INCAENATION.  The  act  whereby  the 
Son  of  God  assumed  the  human  nature ;  or 
the  mystery  by  which  the  Eternal  Word 
was  made  man,  in  order  to  accomplish  the 
work  of  our  salvation. 

The  doctrine  of  the  incarnation  as  laid 
do-vsTi  in  the  third  General  Council,  that  of 
Bphesus  (a.d.  431),  is  as  follows:— "The 
gi'eat  and  holy  synod  (of  Nice)  said,  that  He 
Who  was  begotten  of  the  Father,  as  the 
only-begotten  Son  by  nature  ;  Who  was  true 
God  of  true  God,  Light  of  Light,  by  Whom 
the  Father  made  all  things ;  that  He  de- 
scended, became  incarnate,  and  was  made 
man,  suffered,  rose  on  the  third  day,  and 
ascended  Into  the  heavens."  These  words 
and  doctrines  we  ought  to  follow,  in  con- 
sidering what  is  meant  by  the  Word  of  God 
being  "  incarnate  and  made  man." 

We  do  not  say  that   the   nature  of  the 


398 


INCENSE 


AVord  was  converted  and  became  flesh  ;  nor 
that  it  was  changed  into  perfect  man,  con- 
sisting of  body  and  soul:  but  rather,  that 
the  Word,  uniting  to  Himself  personally 
flesh,  animated  by  a  rational  soul,  became 
man  in  au  ineffable  and  incomprehensible 
manner,  and  became  the  Son  of  man,  not 
mei-ely  by  will  and  affection,  but  that 
different  natures  were  joined  in  a  real  unity, 
and  that  there  is  one  Christ  and  Son,  of  two 
natures ;  the  difference  of  natures  not  being 
taken  away  by  their  union.  It  is  said 
also,  that  He  who  was  before  all  ages  and 
begotten  of  the  Father,  was  "  born  according 
to  the  flesh,  of  a  woman : "  not  as  if  His 
Divine  nature  had  taken  its  beginning  from 
tbe  Holy  Virgin,  but  because  for  us,  and 
for  our  salvation.  He  united  personally  to 
Himself  the  nature  of  man,  and  proceeded 
from  a  woman ;  therefore  He  is  said  to  be 
"  born  according  to  the  flesh."  So  also  we 
say  that  He  "  suffered  and  rose  again,"  not 
as  if  God  the  Word  had  suffered  in  His  own 
nature  the  stripes,  the  nails,  or  the  other 
wounds ;  for  the  Godhead  cannot  suffer,  as 
it  is  incorporeal :  but  because  that  which  had 
become  His  own  body  suffered,  He  is  said 
to  suffer  those  things  for  us.  For  He  who 
was  incapable  of  suffering  was  in  a  suffering 
body.  In  like  manner  we  understand  His 
■"death."  Because  His  own  body,  by  the 
grace  of  God,  as  St.  Paul  said,  tasted  death 
for  every  man.  He  is  said  to  suffer  death. 

INCENSE.  The  use  of  incense  in^con- 
nexion  with  Christian  worship  is  not  men- 
tioned by  writers  in  the  first  three  centuries 
of  the  Christian  jera;  in  fact  there  are 
numerous  passages  in  which  prayer  is  spoken 
of  as  the  only  incense  offered  to  God 
(Clemens  Alex.  Strom,  vii.  6,  32,  &c.).  It 
was  probably  employed  as  a  disinfectant, 
or  to  cover  evil  odours,  but  not  with  any 
rehgious  ceremony  (Tertull.  de  Cor.  Mill, 
c.  10).  In  the  Apostolic  Canons  (c.  3) 
the  words  occur,  "  6vfi,lafia  tm  Kaipa  r^s 
dyiat  npocrcpopas"  ;  but  the  date  of  these 
canons  is  very  uncertain  (See  Apostolical 
Canons').  It  was  used  in  the  time  of  Gregory 
the  Great,  in  the  latter  part  of  the  sixth 
century.  It  then  became  prevalent  in  the 
Church,  but  fell  into  disuse  in  the  Church  of 
England  after  the  Reformation,  and  although 
now  revived  in  some  churches,  has  several 
times  been  decided  to  be  illegal. — Bingham, 
bk.  viii.  6 ;  Did.  Christ.  Ant.  830.     [H.] 

INCOMPHBHENSIBLE.  In  the  Atha- 
nasian  Creed  it  is  said,  that  "  the  Father 
is  incomprehensible,  the  Son  incomprehensi- 
ble, the  Holy  Ghost  incomprehensible;" 
which  means  that  the  Father  is  illimitable, 
the  Son  illimitable,  the  Holy  Ghost  illimit- 
able. At  the  time  when  this  creed  was 
translated,  the  word  incomprehensible  was 
not  confined  to  the  sense  it  now  bears,  of 


INDEPENDENTS 

inconceivable,  or  beyond  the  reach  of  our 
understanding ;  but  it  then  meant,  not 
comprehended  within  limits. 

INCOREUPTICOL/E,  or  Aphthartodo- 
cetas,  or  Phantasiast,-e.  Heretics  who  had 
their  origin  at  Alexandria,  in  the  time  of  the 
emperor  Justinian.  The  beginning  of  the 
controversy  was  among  the  Eutychians, 
whether  the  body  of  Christ  was  corruptible 
or  incorruptible  from  his  conception :  Severus 
held  it  corruptible ;  Julian  of  Halicarnassus 
held  the  contrary,  that  our  Lord's  body  was 
not  obnoxious  to  hunger,  thirst,  or  weariness ; 
and  that  he  did  but  seemingly  suffer  sueh 
things ;  from  whence  they  were  called 
Phantasiastie.  The  emperor  Justinian,  in 
the  very  end  of  his  reign,  favoured  these 
heretics,  and  persecuted  the  orthodox. 

INCUMBENT.  He  who  is  in  present 
possession  of  a  benefice.  It  is  quite  settled 
law  that  the  incumbent  has  complete  control 
over  and  is  responsible  for  the  due  per- 
formances of  divine  service,  and  it  is  particu- 
larly to  be  observed  that  though  curates  are 
personally  responsible  for  their  own  acts,  the 
incumbent  is  responsible  too  for  all  he 
permits  and  sanctions :  Parnell  v.  Boughton, 
6  P.  C.  46 ;  also  that  he  has  full  control 
over  the  organist  and  the  choir.  Sutchins 
V.  Denziloe,  3  Phil.  90 ;  and  Wyndham  v. 
Cole,  in  the  Court  of  Arches,  Oct.  1875. 

INDEPENDENT  METHODISTS  (See 
Gcit'viTh'i/Sis} 

INDEPENDENTS.  A  sect  deriving  its 
name  from  their  principle,  that  every  par- 
ticular congTegation  is  an  independent  body. 
"  The  founder,"  Lord  Macaulay  says,  "  con- 
ceived that  every  Christian  congregation 
had,  under  Christ,  supreme  jurisdiction  in 
things  spiritual ;  that  appeals  to  provincial 
and  national  synods  were  scarcely  less 
unscriptural  than  appeals  to  the  Court  of 
Arches,  or  to  the  Vatican ;  and  that  Popery, 
Prelacy,  and  Presbyterianism  were  merely 
three  forms  of  one  great  apostasy." 

I.  Robert  Brown,  a  clergyman  of  the  English 
Church  in  Elizabeth's  reign,  is  said  to  have 
been  the  first  who  maintained  the  distin- 
guishing doctrine  of  this  sect  in  England ; 
and  they  went  by  the  name  of  Brownists  till 
1642.  Numbers  of  them  were  expelled  from 
the  kingdom,  or  emigrated  in  1583.  But 
Brown  did  not  continue  to  be  their  leader. 
His  "hasty  and'arrogant  spirit"  could  not  be 
borne.  His  relation.  Lord  Burleigh,  got  him 
the  living  of  Thorpe-Aohurch  in  North- 
amptonshire, and  there  he  lived  doing  no 
work,  but  being  constantly  in  trouble.  He 
died  in  Northampton  jail  in  1630,  having 
been  sent  thither  not  for  any  religious  pro- 
fessions, but  because  of  an  assault  on  a 
constable  of  his  parish,  who  was  also  his 
godson  (Hook's  Ecc.  Biog.  iii.  p.  147 ; 
Fuller's  Ch.  Hist.  iii.).    Leaders  of  the  sect. 


INDEPENDENTS 

after  Brown's  influence  had  gone  were 
Barrow,  a  Cambridge  graduate,  and  a  barrister 
of  Gray's  Inn,  of  whom  Lord  Bacon  speaks, 
as  one  who  "  made  a  leap  from  a  vain  and 
libertine  youth,  to  a  preciseness  in  the 
highest  degree,  and  so  was  much  spoken  of  " 
(Bacon's  Works,  i.  383,  Child's  Ed.)  ;  John 
Greenwood,  and  Francis  Johnson,  Fellow  of 
Christ's  College,  Cambridge,  who  established 
a  Brownist  community  at  Amsterdam  (For 
the  history  of  the  early  Independents,  see 
Dr.  Vaughan's  Eist.  of  English  Noncon- 
formity, 1862).  The  English  Independents 
became  a  most  powerful  sect,  and  during  the 
Commonwealth  they  were  active  in  pre- 
venting the  establishment  of  a  Presbyterian 
CHitu-ch  in  England.  In  1662  the  Act  of 
Uniformity  was  passed,  which  excluded  from 
the  ministerial  office  in  the  Church  of 
England,  persons  either  of  the  Independent 
or  Presbyterian  opinions  (See  Uniformity). 
After  another  Act,  the  "  Act  of  Toleration  " 
(see  Toleration),  the  Independent  sect, 
as  indeed  all  the  other  dissenting  sects, 
decreased  in  numbers,  till  the  wonderful 
influence  of  the  Wesleys  and  Whitefield 
caused  a  revival.  Many  persons  then  re- 
fused to  join  the  Wesleyans,  as  was  the 
case  with  Lady  Huntingdon's  Connexion, 
but  they  coalesced  with  the  old  Inde- 
pendents, and  by  this  accession  the  latter 
became  the  largest  dissenting  body  in 
England,  except  the  Wesleyans.  In  1831  a 
Congregational  Union  was  formed,  showing, 
we  may  suppose,  the  weakness  of  the  funda- 
mental principle  of  "Independency."  The 
CongregationaUsts,  or  Independents,  have 
increased  in  numbers  in  proportion  to  the 
increase  of  population. 

The  earliest  aocoxmt  of  the  number  of 
Independent  congregations  refers  to  1812 ; 
before  that  period.  Independent  and  Presby- 
terian congregations  were  returned  together. 
In  1812,  there  seem  to  have  been  1024 
Independent  chapels  in  England  and  Wales 
(799  m  England,  and  225  m  Wales).  In 
1838,  an  estimate  gives  1840  churches  in 
England  and  Wales.  It  is  now  said  that 
there  are  3500  Congregational  or  Indepen- 
dent chapels  in  the  United  Kingdom :  110 
in  Canada,  160  in  Australia ;  beside  mission- 
ary churches  and  colleges  sustained  by  the 
London  Missionary  Society. — Congrega- 
tional Year-Booh. 

II.  In  doctrine  they  are  strictly  Calvin- 
istic.  But  many  of  the  Independents,  both 
at  home  and  abroad,  reject  the  use  of  "  all 
creeds  and  confessions  drawn  up  by  fallible 
men ; "  and  merely  require  of  their  teachers 
a  declaration  of  their  behef  in  the  truth  of 
the  gospel  and  its  leading  doctrines,  and  of 
their  adherence  to  the  Scriptures  as  the  sole 
standard  of  faith  and  practice,  and  the  only 
test  of  doctrine,  or  the  only  criterion  of  faith. 


INDUCTION 


399 


And  in  general  they  require  from  all  persons 
who  wish  to  be  admitted  into  their  commu- 
nion, an  account,  either  verbal  or  written,  of 
what  Ls  called  their  experience ;  in  which, 
not  only  a  declaration  of  their  faith  in  the 
Lord  Jesus,  and  their  purpose,  by  grace,  to 
devote  themselves  to  Him,  is  expected,  iDut 
likewise  a  recital  of  the  steps  by  which  they 
were  led  to  a  knowledge  and  profession  of 
the  gospel. 

In  regard  to  Church  government  and 
discipline,  it  may  be  sufficient  to  remark 
here,  after  what  has  already  been  said,  that 
Independents  in  general  agree  with  the 
Presbyterians  "  in  maintaining  the  identity 
of  presbyters  and  bishops,  and  believe  that 
a  plurality  of  presbyters,  pastors,  or  bishops, 
in  one  church,  is  taught  in  Scripture,  rather 
than  the  common  usage  of  one  bishop  over 
many  congregations ; "  but  they  conceive 
their  own  mode  of  discipline  to  be  "  as  much 
beyond  the  presbyterian  as  presbytery  is' 
preferable  to  prelacy  : "  and  they  assert  that 
one  distinguishing  feature  of  their  discipline  is 
their  maintaining  "  the  right  of  the  Church, 
or  body  of  Christians,  to  determine  who  shall 
be  admitted  into  their  communion,  and  also 
to  exclude  from  their  fellowship  those  who 
may  prove  themselves  rmworthy  members." 

This,  their  regard  to  purity  of  commu- 
nion, whereby  they  profess  to  receive  only 
accredited,  or  really  serious  Christians,  has 
been  termed  the  grand  Independent  principle 
(Stoughton's  Eccl.  Eist).     [H.] 

INDEXES.  The  books  generally  beariug 
the  title  of  Prohibitory  and  Expurgatory  In- 
dexes, are  catalogues  of  authors  and  works 
either  condemned  in  toto,  or  censured  and 
corrected,  chiefly  by  excision,  issued  from 
the  Church  of  modem  Rome,  and  published 
by  authority  of  her  ruling  members  and 
societies  so  empowered. 

The  Prohibitory  Index  specifies  and  pro- 
hibits entire  authors  or  works,  whether  of 
known  or  of  unknown  authors.  This  book 
has  been  frequently  published,  with  succes- 
sive enlargements,  to  the  present  time,  under 
the  express  sanction  of  the  reigning  pontiff. 
It  may  be  considered  as  a  kind  of  periodical 
publication  of  the  papacy. 

The  other  class  of  indexes,  the  Expurga- 
tory, contains  a  particular  examination  of 
the  works  occurring  ia  it,  and  specifies  the 
passages  condemned  to  be  expunged  or 
altered.  Such  a  work,  in  proportion  to  the 
number  of  books  embraced  by  it,  must  be, 
and  in  the  case  of  the  Spanish  indexes  of  the 
kind,  is  voluminous.  For  a  general  history 
of  these  indexes  the  reader  is  referred  to 
Mendham's  "  Literary  Policy  of  the  Church 
of  Home." 

INDUCTION.  This  may  be  compared 
to  livery  and  seisin  of  a  freehold,  for  it  is 
putting  a  minister  in  actual  possession  of 


400 


INDULGENCE 


the  cliurch  to  which  he  is  presented,  and  of 
the  glebe  land  and  other  temporalities 
thereof;  for  before  induction  he  hath  no 
freehold  in  them.  The  usual  method  of 
induction  is  by  virtue  of  a  mandate  under 
the  seal  of  the  bishop,  to  the  archdeacon  of 
the  place,  who  either  himself,  or  by  his 
warrant  to  all  clergymen  within  his  arch- 
deaconry, inducts  the  new  incumbent  by 
taking  his  hand,  laying  it  on  the  key  of  the 
church  in  the  door,  and  pronouncing  these 
words :  "  I  induct  you  into  the  real  and 
actual  possession  of  the  rectory  or  vicarage 

of  H ,  with  all  its  fruits,  members,  and 

appurtenances."  Then  he  opens  the  door 
of  the  church,  and  puts  the  person  in  pos- 
session of  it,  who  enters  to  offer  his  devo- 
tions, which  done,  he  tolls  a  bell  to 
announce  his  induction  to  his  parishioners 
{Official  Tear-Booh,  1886). 

INDULGENCE.  I.  In  the  primitive 
times  this  implied  the  relaxation  of  canonical 
penance,  by  the  bishop,  on  sufficient  evidence 
of  true  repentance.  St.  Basil  speaks  of  it 
in  this  sense  (Can.  74),  and  St.  Chrysostom 
says,  "  Show  your  contrition,  show  your 
reformation,  and  all  is  done"  {Horn.  xiv.  in 
2  Gor.').  And  in  several  councils  it  was  left 
to  the  discretion  of  the  bishops  to  show 
favour  to  true  penitents,  and  to  shorten,  by 
indulgence,  their  time  of  penance  (Gone, 
llerden,  can.  6  ;  Co^ic.  Cliatced.  can.  16).  In 
our  Church  this  is  the  only  allowable  idea 
of  indulgence. — Bingham,  bk.  xviii.  c.  4; 
Bishop  Taylor's  dissuasive  from  Popery, 
Works,  vol.  X.  131,  Heber's  Ed.;  Hooker, 
Ecc.  Pol.  vi.  5,  8,  9. 

II.  Indulgences  in  the  Eoman  Church  are 
a  remission  of  the  punishment  due  to  sins, 
granted  by  the  Church,  and  supposed  to 
save  the  soul  from  Purgatory.  The  con- 
ferring of  indulgences,  which  are  denomi- 
nated "the  heavenly  treasures  of  the 
Chui'ch"  {Gone.  Tri.  Decret.  sess.  xx.),  is 
said  to  be  the  "  gift  of  Christ  to  the  Church  " 
(sess.  XXV.).  To  understand  the  nature  of 
indulgences,  we  must  observe,  that  "  the 
temporal  punishment  due  to  sin,  by  the 
decree  of  God,  when  its  guilt  and  eternal 
punishment  are  remitted,  may  consist  either 
of  evil  in  this  life,  or  of  temporal  suffering 
in  the  next,  which  temporal  suffering  in 
the  next  life  is  called  purgatory ;  that  the 
Church  has  received  power  from  God  to 
remit  both  of  these  inflictions,  and  this  re- 
mission is  called  an  indulgence"  (Butlei-'s 
Book  of  the  Bom.  Gatli.  Ch.  p.  110).  "It 
is  the  received  doctrine  of  the  Roman  Church 
that  an  indulgence,  when  truly  gained,  is 
not  barely  a  relaxation  of  the  canonical 
penance  enjoined  by  the  Church,  but  also 
an  actual  remission  by  God  himself  of  the 
whole,  or  part,  of  the  temporal  punishment 
due  to  it  in  his   sight"  (Milner's  End  of 


INDULGENCE 

Controv.  p.  305).  Indulgences  were  first 
invented  by  Urban  II.  in  the  eleventh  ■ 
centuiy,  as  a  recompence  to  those  who  went 
to  the  holy  war.  Clement  V.  decreed  that  ! 
they  who  sliould,  at  the  jubilee;  visit  such 
and  such  churches,  should  obtain  "  a  most 
full  remission  of  all  their  sins ;  "  and  he 
not  only  granted  a  "plenary  absolution 
of  all  sins,  to  all  who  died  on  the  road  to 
Rome,"  but  "also  commanded  the  angels  of 
paradise  to  carry  the  soul  direct  to  heaven." 
Boniface  VIII.  granted  not  only  a  general, 
but  the  most  fuU  pardon  of  all  sins  to 
all  that  visit  Rome  the  first  year  in  everj- 
century.  Pope  Leo  X.,  in  his  bull  I)e  Jn- 
dulgentiis,  whose  object  he  states  to  be  "  that 
no  one  in  future  may  allege  ignorance  of  the 
doctrine  of  the  Roman  Church  respecting 
indulgences,  and  their  efficacy,"  declares, 
"  that  the  Roman  pontiff,  vicar  of  Christ  on 
earth,  can,  for  reasonable  causes,  by  the 
powers  of  the  keys,  grant  to  the  faithful, 
whether  in  this  life  or  in  purgatory,  indul- 
gences out  of  the  superabundance  of  the 
merits  of  Christ  and  of  the  saints  (expressly 
called  a  treasure)  ;  and  that  those  who  have 
truly  obtained  these  indulgences  are  released 
from  so  much  of  the  temporal  punishment 
due  for  their  actual  sins  to  the  Divine  j  ustice, 
as  is  equivalent  to  the  indulgence  granted 
and  obtained"  {Bulla  Leom.  X.  adv. 
Luther).  Clement  XI.,  in  the  bull  Uni- 
genitus,  speaks  most  extravagantly  on  the 
subject,  as  do  many  other  of  the  popes.  "  We 
have  resolved,"  says  Pope  Leo  XII.,  in  his 
bull  of  indiction  for  the  universal  jubilee, 
in  1824,  "  in  virtue  of  the  authority  given 
us  by  heaven,  fully  to  unlock  that  sacred 
treasure,  composed  of  the  merits,  sufferings, 
and  virtues  of  Christ  our  Lord,  and  of  His 
Virgin  Mother,  and  of  all  the  saints,  which 
the  author  of  human  salvation  has  intrusted 
to  our  dispensation.  During  this  year  of 
the  jubilee,  we  mercifully  give  and  grant,  in 
the  Lord  a  plenary  indulgence,  remission, 
and  pardon  of  all  their  sins,  to  all  the  faithful 
of  Christ,  truly  penitent  and  confessing  their 
sins,  and  receiving  the  holy  communion,  who 
shall  visit  the  churches  of  blessed  Peter  and 
Paul,"  &c. 

The  first  General  Lateran  Council  granted 
"  remission  of  sins  to  whoever  shall  go  to 
Jerusalem,  and  effectually  help  to  oppose 
the  infidels"  (Can.  xi.).  The  third  and 
fourth  Lateran  Councils  granted  the  same 
indulgence  to  those  who  set  themselves  to 
destroy  heretics,  or  who  shall  take  up  arms 
against  them  (See  Labbe,  vol.  x.). 

The  Council  of  Trent  confirmed  this 
"  novel  and  strange  doctrine ;  "  and  it  was 
against  these  indulgences  that  Luther  had 
so  firmly  set  himself.  Long  before  Luther, 
however,  this  abuse  had  rankled  in  the 
heart  of  Christendom.     It  was  in  vain  for 


INDULGENOK 

the  Church  to  assert  that,  rightly  under- 
stood, indulgences  only  released  from  tem- 
poral penances ;  that  they  were  a  commu- 
tation, a  merciful,  lawful  commutation  for 
such  penances.  The  language  of  the  pro- 
mulgators and  vendors  of  the  indulgences, 
even  of  the  indulgences  themselves,  was,  to 
the  vulgar  ear,  the  broad,  plain,  direct 
guarantee  from  the  pains  of  purgatory,  from 
hell  itself,  for  tens,  hundreds,  thousands  of 
years;  a  sweeping  pardon  for  all  sins 
committed,  a  sweeping  licence  for  sins  to  be 
committed;  and  if  this  false  construction, 
as  it  might  be,  was  perilous  to  the  irre- 
ligious, the  seeming  flagrant  dissociation  of 
morality  from  religion  was  no  less  revolting 
to  the  religious.  No  testimony  can  be  pro- 
duced from  any  Father,  or  any  document  of 
the  ancient  Church,  that  either  this  doctrine, 
or  the  practice  of  such  indulgences,  was 
known  or  used  for  1000  years. — Milman's 
Lat.  Clirist.  vol.  vi.  p.  436  :  see  also  note, 
437 ;  Clementius,  Exam.  Cone.  Trid.  de 
Indulg.  c.  4;  J.  Taylor,  ut  sup.,  p.  141 
(where  the  subject  is  treated  at  length,  and 
the  doctrine  confuted) ;  Lingard,  vi.  89 ; 
Bellarmine,  de  Indulg.  cc.  2,  3  (For  English 
forms  of  indulgence  see  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit. 
iii.  372).     [H.] 

INDULGENCE  SUNDAY.  A  name 
given  to  the  first  day  in  Holy  Week  in  the 
Lectionaryof  St.  Jerome,  and  by  later  writers. 
It  has  been  supposed  that  the  term  origi- 
nated from  the  custom  of  the  Christian 
emperors  of  setting  prisoners  free  on  that 
day,  and  closing  the  courts  of  law  during  the 
week.  But  this  did  not  take  place  before 
the  end  of  the  fourth  century,  and  the  term 
was  older  than  that.  Most  probably  it  was 
intended  to  refer  to  our  Lord's  indulgence, 
in  His  work  of  redemption :  and  in  this  sense 
the  words  occur  in  the  Gregorian  Sacramen- 
tary,  "  per  quern  nobis  indulgentia  largitur ; " 
and  again,  "  ut  indulgentiam  percipere  mer- 
eamur  "  (See  Palm- Sunday).    [H.] 

JNDULT  (Lat.  indultum),  in  the  Church 
of  Eome,  is  a  power  of  presenting  to  benefices, 
granted  to  certain  persons  by  the  pope.  Of 
this  kind  is  the  Indult  of  kings  and  sovereign 
princes  and  cardinals  in  the  Eomish  com- 
munion, and,  formerly,  that  of  the  parliament 
of  Paris.  The  power  of  nominating  to  bishop- 
rics was  granted  to  Francis  I.  by  Pope  Leo  X., 
A.D.  1516,  and  similar  grants  were  made  by 
later  popes. 

The  cardinals  have  an  Indult  granted 
them  by  agreement  between  Pope  Paul  IV. 
and  the  sacred  college,  in  1555,  which  is 
always  confirmed  by  the  popes  at  the  time 
of  their  election.  By  this  treaty  or  agree- 
ment the  cardinals  have  the  free  disposal  of 
all  the  benefices  depending  on  them,  without 
being  interrupted  by  any  prior  collations  from 
the  pope. 


INFINITY 


401 


INFALLIBILITY  OF  THE  CHURCH. 
In  one  sense  the  universal  Church  is  infal- 
lible. It  has  an  infallible  guide  in  the  Holy 
Scriptures.  Holy  Scripture  contains  all  re- 
ligious truth ;  and  the  Church  having  the 
Scriptures,  is  so  far  infallibly  guided.  But 
there  is  no  infallible  guide  to  the  interpreta- 
tion of  Scripture.  If  it  were  so,  then  there 
would  be  an  authority  above  the  Scriptures. 
Hence  the  wisdom  of  om-  twentieth  Article : 
"  The  Church  hath  power  to  decree  rites  or 
ceremonies,"  &c.  In  this  the  authority  of 
the  Church  in  subordination  to  Scripture  is 
clearly  laid  down.  To  the  same  eflfect  is  our 
twenty-first  Article.  "General  Councils," 
&c.,  which  ends :  "  Wherefore  things  ordained 
by  them  as  necessary  to  salvation  have 
neither  strength  nor  authority,  unless  it 
may  be  declared  that  they  be  taken  out  of 
holy  Scripture  " — Waterland,  in  "  Impor- 
tance of  the  Doctrine  of  the  Holy  Trinity." 
Chillingworth,  Beveridge. 

Thus  the  Church  of  England  ever  upholds 
the  authority  of  the  Church,  and  accepts 
the  doctrine  of  the  general  councils,  while 
at  the  same  time  she  repudiates  the  idea  of 
infallibility  as  taught  by  the  Church  of 
Rome.  That  Church  asserts  the  infalUbiUty 
(i.)  of  the  Fathers.  "Our  constant  and 
avowed  doctrine  is,  that  the  doctrine  of  the 
Fathers,  speaking  of  them  properly  as  such, 
is  infallible"  (see  Fathers);  (ii.)  of  the 
councils,  whether  they  are  general  or  no,  if 
only  connected  with  the  Roman  Church ;  (iii.) 
of  the  Pope. — Bishop  Taylor's  Works,Heber's 
Ed.,  viii.  52:x.313. 

"The  Council  of  Trent  published  no  defi- 
nition on  this  point.  Suarez  says  that  the 
Pope's  infallibihty  is  a  question  of  faith; 
Bellarmine,  that  it  is  not;  and  Stapleton, 
that,  though  the  denial  of  it  is  scandalous  and 
offensive,  it  is  perhaps  not  heretical ;  wlule 
Gerson,  with  a  very  large  and  learned  school 
of  Roman  theologians,  rejects  the  doctrine 
altogether.  But  the  matter  has  been  settled 
for  the  Church  of  Rome  by  Pope  Pius  IX., 
who  in  A.D.  1870  declared  the  Pope  infal- 
Uble.     [H.] 

INFANT  BAPTISM  (See  Baptism,  In- 
fant). 

INFINITY.  An  attribute  of  God.  The 
idea  of  infinity  or  immensity  is  so  closely 
connected  with  that  of  self-existence,  that, 
because  it  is  impossible  but  that  something 
must  be  infinite,  independently  and  of  itself, 
therefore  it  must  of  necessity  be  self-existent : 
and  because  something  must  of  necessity  be 
self-existent,  therefore  it  is  necessary  that  it 
must  likewise  be  infinite.  A  necessarily 
existent  being  must  be  everywhere  as  well  as 
always  unalterably  the  same.  For  a  neces- 
sity, which  is  not  everywhere  the  same,  is 
plainly  a  consequential  necessity  only,  de- 
pending upon  some  external  cause.     What- 

2  D 


402 


INFIEMARIAN 


ever  therefore  exists  by  an  absolute  necessity 
in  its  own  nature,  must  needs  be  infinite,  as 
well  as  eternal.  To  suppose  a  finite  being  to 
be  self-existent,  is  to  say,  that  it  is  a  contra- 
diction for  that  being  not  to  exist,  the  ab- 
sence of  which  may  yet  be  conceived  without 
a  contradiction,  which  is  the  greatest  absur- 
dity in  the  world. 

From  hence  it  follows  that  the  infinity  of 
the  self-existent  Being  must  be  an  infinity 
of  fulness,  as  well  as  of  immensity ;  that  is, 
it  must  not  only  be  without  limits,  but  also 
without  diversity,  defect,  or  interruption. 
It  follows,  likewise,  that  the  self-existent 
Being  must  be  a  most  simple,  unchangeable, 
incorruptible  Being,  without  parts,  figure, 
motion,  divisibility,  or  any  other  such 
properties,  as  we  find  in  matter.  For  all 
these  things  plainly  and  necessarily  imply 
fimiteness  in  their  very  notion,  and  are 
utterly  inconsistent  with  complete  infinity. 

As  to  the  particular  manner  in  which  the 
Supreme  Being  is  infinite,  or  everywhere 
present — this  is  as  impossible  for  our  finite 
understandings  to  comprehend  and  explain, 
as  it  is  for  us  to  form  an  adequate  idea  of 
infinity.  The  schoolmen  have  presumed  to 
assert  that  the  immensity  of  God  is  a  point, 
as  his  eternity  (they  think)  is  an  instant. 
But  this  being  altogether  unintelligible,  we 
may  more  safely  afBrm,  that  the  Supreme 
Caiise.is  at  all  times  equally  present,  both 
in  his  simple  essence,  and  by  the  immediate 
and  perfect  exercise  of  all  his  attributes,  to 
every  point  of  the  boundless  immensity,  as 
if  it  were  really  all  but  one  single  point. 
The  Latin  version  of  the  Te  Deum  renders 
"  of  an  infinite  majesty,"  "  immensa;  majes- 
tatis."  The  same  epithet,  which  means  "  im- 
measurable," is  used  in  the  Athanasian  Creed 
to  imply  "incomprehensible"  (See  Incom- 
prehensible). 

INFIEMARIAN.  An  officer  in  a  mon- 
astery, who  had  the  care  of  the  sick  and 
infirm.  A  dignitary  in  Nice  Cathedral  was 
so  called. 

INITIATED.  In  the  early  ages  of  the 
Church,  this  term  was  applied  to  those  who 
had  been  baptized  and  admitted  to  a  know- 
ledge of  the  higher  mysteries  of  the  gospel. 
The  discipline  of  the  Church  at  that  period 
made  it  necessary  that  candidates  for  baptism 
should  pass  through  a  long  probation,  in  the 
character  of  catechumens.  While  in  this 
preparatory  state,  they  were  not  allowed  to 
be  present  at  the  celebration  of  the  Eucha- 
rist; and  in  sermons  and  homilies  in  their 
presence,  the  speaker  either  waived  alto- 
gether any  direct  statement  of  the  sublimer 
doctrines  of  Christianity,  or  alluded  to  them 
in  an  oDscure  manner,  not  intelligible  to  the 
uninitiated,  but  sufficiently  clear  to  be  in- 
terpreted by  those  for  whom  they  were 
intended,  viz.   the  baptized    or    initiated. 


INJUNCTIONS 

Hence  the  phrase  so  common  in  the  homilies 
of  the  Fathers,  "  the  initiated  understand 
what  is  said,"  St.  Chrysostom  and  St. 
Augustine  using  it  at  least  fifty  times. — 
Casaubon,  Exerc.  16  in  Baron,  p.  399. 

INJUNCTIONS.  I.  Of  September,  1547. 
These  are  important  as  showing  the  spirit 
by  which  the  English  Reformers  were  ani- 
mated. They  were  eleven  in  number,  and 
directed  on  the  one  hand  against  super- 
stitious abuses,  which  had  taken  hold  of  the 
people,  and  on  the  other  against  the  negli- 
gence of  the  clergy.  They  were  (1)  that 
the  clergy  should  not  encourage  the  people 
to  pay  reverence  to  relics,  or  make  pilgrim- 
ages to  shrines ;  but  should  teach  that  health 
(salvation)  and  grace  ought  to  be  sought  for 
from  God  only ;  (2)  that  the  clergy  should 
preach  at  least  once  in  each  quarter  of  the 
year,  exhort  their  people  to  the  practice  of 
those  virtues  and  graces  enjoined  in  Scrip- 
ture ;  and  should  denounce  such  things  as 
ofiering  candles  and  tapers,  or  kissing  or 
Hcking  the  same,  prayer  upon  beads,  or  such 
like  superstitions;  (3)  that  images  which 
had  been  worshipped  should  be  destroyed, 
and  no  lights  should  be  burnt  before  any 
image  or  picture,  "  but  only  two  lights  upon 
the  high  altar,  before  the  Sacrament,  which, 
for  the  signification  that  Christ  is  the  very 
true  Light  of  the  world,  they  shall  remain 
still  "  (see  Lights) ;  (4),  (5),  (6),  (7)  order  the 
reading  and  reciting  the  Scriptures,  Epistles 
and  Gospels,  Lord's  Prayer,  Credo,  and 
Litany,  in  English :  and  direct  that  an 
English  version  of  the  Bible  should  be  set 
up  in  the  church  for  the  use  of  parishioners ; 

(8)  that  all  shrines,  coverings  of  shrines, 
tables,  candlesticks,  trindles  or  rolls  of  wax, 
pictures,  paintings,  and  all  other  monuments 
of  feigned  miracles,  &c.,  should  be  destroyed ; 

(9)  a  pulpit  to  be  provided  by  the  church- 
wardens ;  (10)  one  of  the  homilies  to  be  read 
every  Sunday;  (11)  that  all  persons  who 
did  not  imderstand  Latin  were  to  use  King 
Henry's  Primer. 

II.  Of  October  in  the  same  year.  These 
ordered  that  matins  should  be  celebrated  at  6, 
and  evensong  and  compline  at  3,  from  Lady 
Day  to  October  1 :  and  at  7,  and  2  or  2.30, 
during  the  rest  of  the  year ;  that  only  one 
mass  should  be  celebrated  daily,  at  9  a.m.;  that 
the  singing  of  hours,  prime,  dirige  (seeDirge) 
commendations  should  be  discontinued. 

III.  Of  Queen  Elizabeth.  By  1  Mary,  s.  2, 
c.  2,  the  alterations  made  in  the  reign  of 
Edward  VI.  were  abolished ;  and  so,  whether 
the  Injunctions  of  1547  had  the  force  of  an 
Act  of  Parliament  or  not,  they  ceased  to  be 
of  any  authority.  The  Injunctions  of  1559 
were  founded  upon  those  of  1547,  and  were 
followed  by  certain  "  Interpretations,  and 
further  considerations  (See  Advertise- 
ments).    [H.] 


INNOCENTS'  DAY 

INNOCENTS'  DAY.  One  of  the  holy- 
■days  of  the  Church,  observed  December  28. 
The  iimocents  were  they  who  suffered  death 
under  the  cruel  decree  of  Herod,  who 
thought,  by  a  general  slaughter  of  young 
-children,  to  have  accomplished  the  death  of 
the  infant  Jesus.  They  are  so  called  from 
'the  Latin  term  innocenies  or  innocui,  harm- 
less babes,  altogether  incapable  of  defending 
themselves  from  the  malice  of  their  inhuman 
[persecutors.  The  celebration  of  the  martyr- 
dom of  these  innocents  was  very  ancient.^ — ■ 
Orig.  Horn.  3,  De  Diversis;  Cypr.  Ep.  56, 
ad  Thtbar. ;  Aug.  de  Lit  Art.  3,  23. 

INQUISITION.  A  tribunal  or  court  of 
justice,  in  Roman  Catholic  countries,  erected 
by  the  popes  for  the  examination  and  pun- 
ishment of  Jieretics. 

Before  the  conversion  of  the  empire  to 
Christianity,  there  was  no  other  tribunal  for 
-the  inquiry  into  matters  of  faith  and  doctrine 
iDUt  that  of  the  bishops ;  nor  any  other  way 
■of  punishing  obstinate  heretics  but  that  of 
excommunication.  But  the  Eoman  em- 
perors, being  converted  to  Christianity, 
thought  themselves  obliged  to  interpose  in 
the  punishment  of  crimes  committed  against 
God,  and  for  this  purpose  made  laws  (which 
may  be  found  in  the  Theodosian  and  Jus- 
tinian codes),  by  which  heretics  were  sen- 
tenced to  banishment  and  forfeiture  of  es- 
tates. Thus  there  were  two  courts  of  judi- 
cature against  heretics,  the  one  spiritual,  the 
other  civil.  The  ecclesiastical  court  pro- 
nounced upon  the  right,  declared  what  was 
heresy,  and  excommunicated  heretics.  When 
this  was  done,  the  civil  courts  undertook 
"the  prosecution,  and  punished  those,  in  their 
persons  and  fortunes,  who  were  convicted  of 
heresy. 

This  method  lasted  tiU  after  the  year 
€00.  From  this  time  the  jurisdiction  of 
"the  Western  bishops  orer  heretics  was 
engaged,  and  they  had  now  authority  both 
to  convict  and  punish  them,  by  imprison- 
jnent  and  several  acts  of  discipline,  war- 
ranted, by  the  canons  and  custom :  but  they 
could  not  execute  the  imperial  kws  of 
T)anishment  upon  them.  Matters  stood 
thus  untU  the  twelfth  century,  when  the 
:great  growth  and  power  of  heresies  (as  they 
-were  called)  began  to  give  no  small  dis- 
turbance to  the  Church.  However,  the 
popes  could  do  no  more  than  send  legates 
and  preachers  to  endeavour  to  convert  the 
Tieretics,  particvilarly  the  Alligenses,  who 
in  the  13th  century  were  the  occasion  of 
great  disturbances  in  Languedoc.  Hither 
Father  Dominic  and  his  followers  (called 
from  him  Dominicans')  were  sent  by  Pope 
Innocent  IH.  a.d.  1208,  with  orders  to  excite 
the  Catholic  princes  and  people  to  extirpate 
heretics,  to  inquire  out  their  number  and 
■quality,  and  to  transmit  a  faithful  account 


INSPIRATION 


403 


thereof  to  Piome;  hence  they  were  called 
Inquisitors  ;  and  this  gave  birth  to  the  for- 
midable tribunal  of  the  Inquisition,  which 
was  established  in  all  Italy,  and  it  was 
also  introduced  into  Germany  and  France. 
In  the  latter  country  it  was  exercised  with 
great  severity  for  a  time,  but  was  soon 
discontinued,  though  an  unsuccessful  at- 
tempt was  made  to  revive  it  under  Henry 
II.  against  the  Huguenots.  In  Germany  it 
fell  into  disuse  at  the  Reformation.  In 
England  it  was  never  received,  prosecutions 
against  heresy  being  carried  on  in  the 
ordinary  courts.  In  Spain,  where  it  was 
first  introduced  in  1248,  and  in  Portugal, 
the  greatest  atrocities  were  committed  by 
the  Inquisition,  the  usual  punishment  for 
those  found  guilty  by  the  tribunal  being  a 
lingering  death  by  burning,  besides  preli- 
minary tortures  to  make  the  accused  confess 
(See  Auto  dafe).  It  was  finally  abolished 
in  1835. 

The  Inquisition  of  Goa,  in  the  Indies,  was 
very  powerful,  the  principal  inquisitor  hav- 
ing more  respect  shown  him  than  either 
the  archbishop  or  viceroy. 

The  Inquisition  of  Venice,  consisting  of 
the  pope's  nuncio  residing  there,  the  pa- 
triarch of  Venice,  the  father  inquisitor,  and 
two  senators,  was  not  nearly  so  severe  as 
those  of  Spain  and  Portugal.  It  did  not 
hinder  the  Greeks  and  Armenians  from  the 
exercise  of  their  rehgion;  and  it  tolerated 
the  Jews,  who  wore  scarlet  caps  for  the  sake 
of  distinction.  In  fine,  the  power  of  this 
tribunal  was  so  limited  by  the  States,  that,  in 
the  university  of  Padua,  degrees  were  taken 
without  requiring  the  candidates  to  make 
the  profession  of  faith  enjoined  by  the 
popes;  insomuch  that  schismatics,  Jews, 
and  those  they  call  heretics,  could  freely  take 
their  degrees  in  law  and  physic  there. 

The  Inquisition  of  Some  was  a  congrega- 
tion of  twelve  cardinals,  and  some  other 
officers,  and  the  pope  presided  in  it  in 
person.  This  was  accounted  the  highest 
tribunal  in  Home.  It  was  founded  a.d. 
1543,  in  the  time  of  Pope  Paul  III.,  on 
occasion  of  the  spreading  of  Lutheranism  ; 
its  powers  were  confirmed  and  extended  by 
Pius  IV.  A.D.  1564,  reorganized  by  Sixtus  V. 
in  1588,  suppressed  by  Napoleon  Bonaparte 
in  1808. 

INSPIRATION  (See  Eoly  Ghost). 
I.  The  extraordinary  and  supernatural  in- 
fluence of  the  Spirit  of  God  on  the  human 
mind,  by  which  the  prophets  and  sacred 
vrriters  were  qualified  to  receive  and  set 
forth  Divine  communications,  without  any 
mixture  of  error.  In  this  sense  the  term 
occurs  in  2  Tim.  iii.  16.  "  All  Scripture  is 
given  by  inspiration  of  God,"  &c.  (See 
Scriptures,  Inspiration  of). 

II.  The  word  inspiration  also  expresses 
2  D  2 


404 


INSTALLATION 


tiiat  ordinary  operation  of  the  Spirit,  by 
■which,  men  are  inwardly  moved  and  excited 
hoth  to  will  and  to  do  such  things  as  are 
pleasing  to  God,  and  through  which  all  the 
powers  of  their  minds  are  elevated,  purified, 
.and  invigorated.  "  There  is  a  spirit  in  man ; 
and  the  inspiration  of  the  Almighty  giveth 
them  understanding"  (Job  xxxii.  8).  In 
this  latter  sense  the  term  and  its  kindred 
verb  frequently  appear  in  the  offices  of  tlie 
Church ;  as  in  the  petitions,  "  Grant,  that 
by  thy  holy  inspiration  we  may  think 
those  things  that  are  good ; "  "  Cleanse  the 
thoughts  of  our  hearts  by  the  inspiration 
of  thy  Holy  Sphit;"  "Beseeching  thoe 
to  inspire  continually  the  universal  Church 
with  the  Spirit  of  truth,  unity,  and  con- 
cord;" and 

•*  Come,  Holy  Ghost,  onr  souls  iTispiVc, 
And  lighten  with  celestial  fire  ;" 

•*  Visit  our  minds,  into  our  hearts 
Thy  heavenly  grace  inspire." 

INSTALLATION.  The  act  of  giving 
visible  possession  of  his  ofSce  to  a  canon 
or  prebendary  of  a  cathedral,  by  placing 
him  in  his  stall.  It  is  also  apphed  to  the 
placing  of  a  bishop  in  his  episcopal  throne 
in  his  cathedral  church ;  enthronization 
being  said  to  be  proper  to  archbishops 
only;  but  this  appears  a  technical  and 
imreal  distinction  invented  in  the  middle 
ages. 

The  installation  of  the  Knights  of  the 
Garter  is  a  religious  ceremony,  performed 
in  the  Chapel  of  St.  George,  at  Windsor 
(See  AsJanole's  Institution  of  the  Order  of 
the  Garter).  Those  of  the  Knights  of  the 
Bath  in  Henry  VIL's  Chapel  in  West- 
minster Abbey,  and  of  the  Knights  of  St. 
Patrick  in  the  Cathedral  of  St.  Patrick's 
in  Dublin,  are,  according  to  the  statutes  of 
the  orders,  conducted  upon  the  same  model. 

INSTITUTION.  The  act  by  which  the 
bishop  commits  to  a  clergyman  the  cure  of 
a  church. 

Canon  40.  "  To  avoid  the  detestable 
sin  of  simony,  every  archbishop,  bishop,  or 
other  person  having  authority  to  admit, 
institute,  or  collate,  to  any  spiritual  or  ec- 
clesiastical function,  dignity,  or  benefice, 
shall,  before  every  such  admission,  institu- 
tion, or  collation,  minister  to  every  person 
to  be  admitted,  instituted,  or  collated,  the 
oath  against  simony." 

The  following  papers  are  to  be  sent  to 
the  bishop  by  the  clergyman,  who  is  to  be 
instituted  or  collated : — 

1.  Presentation  to  the  benefice  or  ca- 
thedral preferment,  duly  stamped  and  exe- 
cuted by  the  patron  [or  petition,  not  on 
stamp,  if  the  person  to  he  instituted  happens 
to  be  patron  of  the  benefice.'] 

The  stamp  duty  upon  presentations  is 
now  regulated  by  the  Acts  5  &  6  Vict.  c. 


INSTITUTION 

79,  and  6  &  7  Vict.  c.  72,  and  it  is  an  ad 
valorem  duty  upon  the  net  yearly  value  of 
the  preferment  or  benefice,  such  value  to 
be  ascertained  by  the  certificate  of  the 
ecclesiastical  commissioners  for  England 
indorsed  upon  the  instrument  of  presenta- 
tion. 

The  following  is  the  scale  of  stamp  duty 
to  which  presentations  are  liable : — 
Where    the    annual    value    is 

under  £300  .  .  .  £5  stamp. 

If  it  amounts  to  £300  and  is 

less  than  £400     .         .         .10 
If  it  amounts  to  £400  and  is 

less  than  £500     .         .         .15 
If  it  amounts  to  £500  and  is 

less  than  £600     .         .         .     20 
and  so  on ;  an  additional  £5  being  required 
for  every  £100  annual  value. 

In  the  case  of  collations,  and  also  of  in- 
stitutions proceeding  upon  the  petition  of 
the  patron,  the  certificate  of  yearly  value 
must  be  written  upon,  and  the  stamp  af- 
fixed to,  the  instrument  of  collation,  or  of 
institution,  respectively. 

The   following  is  the   scale  of  duty  to- 
which  collations  and  institutions  proceeding 
upon  petition  are  liable : — 
Where    the    annual    value    is 

under  £300  ...  £7  stamp. 
If  it  amounts  to  £300  and  is 

less  than  £400     .         .         .     12 
If  it  amounts  to  £400  and  is 

less  than  £500     .         .         .17 
If  it  amounts   to  £500  and  is 

less  than  £600    .         .  .22 

and  so  on ;  an  additional  £5  being  requiredi 
for  every  £100  annual  value. 

In  order  to  procure  the  certificate  of 
value  from  the  ecclesiastical  commissioners, 
application  should  be  made  by  the  secretary 
to  the  commissioners,  in  the  following 
from : — • 
Application  for  Certificate  of  the  valve  of 

a  Living  under  5  <fc  6  Vict.  c.  79,  and  6  & 

7  Vict.  c.  72. 

TO      THE      ECCLESIASTICAL       COMMISSIOKEBS 


FOB   ENGLAND. 


The 


,    of  ,   in  the  county  of 

,    and    diocese  of  ,  and    in    the 

patronage  of  ,  having  become  vacant 

on  the day  of last,  by  the of 

the  Bev.  ;  and  the  Rev.  being 

about  to  be thereto,  the  ecclesiastical 

commissioners  for  England  are  requested  to 
certil'y  the  net  yearly  value  thereof,  ac- 
cording to  the  provisions  of  the  Acts  5  &  6' 
Vict.  c.  79,  and  6  &  7  Vict.  c.  72. 

{Date) . 

(^Signature} . 

In  answer  to  this  application,  a  form  of 
certificate  will  be  sent  from  the  office  of  the 


INSTITUTION 

ecclesiastical  commissioners,  which  is  to  be 
indorsed  on  the  instrument  of  presentation, 
.&c.,  and  then  transmitted  to  the  same  of&ce 
for  signature ;  after  which,  the  presentation, 
&c.,  will,  on  its  being  taken  to  the  Stamp 
•OflSce,  be  properly  stamped. 

2.  Letters  of  orders,  deacon,  and  priest. 

3.  Letters  testimonial  by  three  beneficed 
■clergymeo,  in  the  following  form : — 

To  the  Eight  Eeverend  ■ ,  Lord 

Bishop  of . 

We,  whose  names  are  hereunder  written 
testify  and  make  known,  that  A.  B.,  clerk, 
A.M.  (or  other  degree),  presented  (or  to  be 
•collated,  as  the  case  may  he)  to  the  canonry, 
&c.,  &c.  (or  to  the  rectory  or  vicarage,  oi 

the  case  may  he),  of ,  in  the  county  of 

,  in  your  lordship's  diocese,  hath  been 

personally  known  to  us  for  the  space  of 
three  years  last  past;  that  we  have  had 
■opportunities  of  observing  his  conduct ; 
that,  during  the  whole  of  that  time, 
we  verily  believe  that  he  lived  piously, 
fioberly,  and  honestly ;  nor  have  we  at  any 
time  heard  anything  to  the  contrary  thereof; 
nor  hath  he  at  any  time,  as  far  as  we  know 
or  believe,  held,  written,  or  taught  anything 
contrary  to  the  doctrine  or  discipline  of  the 
United  Church  of  England  and  Ireland ; 
and,  moreover,  we  believe  him  in  our 
consciences  to  be,  as  to  his  moral  conduct,  a 
person  worthy  to  be  admitted  to  the  said 
■canonry,  or  benefice  (as  the  case  may  he). 
In  witness  whereof  we  have  hereunto  set 

our  hands,  this day  of ,  in  the 

year  of  our  Lord  18 — 

C.  D.  rector  of . 

E.  P.    vicar  of . 

G-.  H.  rector  of . 

(Official  Tear-Booh  of  the  Church  of 
England,  p.  639). 

If  aU  the  subscribers  are  not  beneficed  in 
the  diocese  of  the  bishop  to  whom  the 
testimonial  is  addressed,  the  counter- 
signature of  the  bishop  of  the  diocese 
wherein  their  benefices  are  respectively 
situate  is  required. 

4.  A  short  statement  of  the  title  of  the 
jiatron  in  case  of  a  change  of  patron  since 
the  last  incumbent  was  presented. 

The  same  subscriptions  and  declarations 
are  to  be  made,  and  oaths  taken,  as  by  a 
clergyman  on  being  licensed  to  a  perpetual 
curacy  (See  Curacy). 

If  the  clergyman  presented,  or  to  be 
collated,  should  be  in  possession  of  other 
preferment,  it  will  be  necessary  for  him 
(if  he  wishes  to  continue  to  hold  a  cathedral 
preferment,  or  a  benefice  with  the  cathedral 
-preferment,  or  benefice  to  which  he  has 
teen  presented,  or  is  to  be  collated,)  to  look 
±0  the  provisions  of  the  Act  1  &  2  Vict.  c. 


INTENTION 


405 


106,  sect.  1  to  sect.  14,  before  he  is  insti- 
tuted or  collated  (See  Pluralities). 

INSTITUTION  OP  A  CHRISTIAN 
MAN,  or  "  THE  BISHOP'S  BOOK."  This 
followed  the  "  Articles  to  establish  Christian 
quietness,"  which  were  put  forth  by  the 
authority  of  Henry  VIII.  in  1536,  and  was 
intended  to  explain  the  Creed,  the  Lord's 
Prayer,  the  Ten  Commandments,  and  the 
Sacraments.  It  is  interesting  to  compare 
this  book  with  that  which  is  called  the 
"  King's  Book,"  published  about  six  years 
later,  and  in  which  the  infiuence  of  Grar- 
dhier  is  manifest.  The  chief  points  in  the 
"  Bishops'  Book  "  are  "  Justification  by  the 
only  merits  of  Jesus  Christ "  (60) ;  "  Good 
works  not  in  themselves  deserving  of  re- 
ward"; "Christ  the  only  mediator"  (45); 
"The  authority  of  the  Pope  to  be  re- 
nounced" (55).  In  the  "King's  Book" 
these  matters  are  treated  in  a  very  dif- 
ferent way,  and  in  fact  there  was  a  re- 
trograde movement.  But  it  was  only 
for  a  time,  and  the  "  Institution  of  a 
Christian  Man "  did  its  work  in  the  histoiy 
of  the  Reformation. — ^Burnet's  Reform,  i. 
228-9;  Blunt's  Parish  Prie«<  (Murray),  pp. 
115  seq.,  324  (See  BisJwfs  Book). 

INTENTION.  (1)  A  motion  of  the 
will,  by  which  it  is  proposed  or  intended  to 
accomplish  or  obtain  a  certain  end.  "In 
every  action,"  says  Jeremy  Taylor,  "  reflect 
upon  the  end ;  and  in  your  undertaking  it, 
consider  why  you  do  it,  and  what  you  pro- 
pound to  yourself  for  a  reward,  and  to  your 
action  as  its  end."  "Intentions"  are  the 
particular  objects  which  we  wish  to  gain 
(whether  for  ourselves  or  others)  by  any  act 
of  devotion. 

(2)  But  the  word  is  used  in  a  different 
sense  in  the  Roman  Church.  On  this  sub- 
ject the  following  is  the  eleventh  canon  of 
the  Council  of  Trent : — "  If  any  shall  say 
that  there  is  not  required  in  the  ministers 
while  they  perform  and  confer  the  sacra- 
ments, at  least  the  intention  of  doing  what 
the  Church  does,  let  him  be  accursed." 

This  is  a  fearful  assertion,  which  supposes 
it  to  be  in  the  power  of  every  malicious  or 
sceptical  priest  to  deprive  the  holiest  of 
God's  worshippers  of  the  grace  which  is 
sought  in  the  sacraments.  There  is  mention 
of  this  notion  in  the  Constitutions  of  Martin 
v.,  and  in  Pope  Eugenius's  letter  to  the 
Armenians  at  the  Council  of  Plorence ;  but 
this  was  the  first  time  that  a  reputed  general 
council  sanctioned  it. 

Our  26th  Article  of  Religion  virtually 
repudiates  this  extreme  doctrine  of  "  Inten- 
tion," declaring  that  the  effect  of  a  sacrament 
(where  there  is  faith  in  the  receiver)  flows 
from  its  due  administration  as  to  form  and 
words  ;  and  whatever  the  wickedness  of  the 
minister,  this  is  no  bar  to  its  vahdity.    [H.] 


406 


INTERCESSION 


INTERCESSION  (derived  from  Lat.  in- 
iercedere,  to  go  between).  A  pleading  or 
entreating  in  behalf  of  another.  It  is  spoken 
(1)  of  the  intercession  of  our  Lord  for 
His  Church  and  people  (Rom.  viii.  34; 
Heb.  vii.  25) ;  (2)  of  the  Holy  Ghost  in 
God's  children  (Rom.  viii.  26  ) ;  (3)  of  the 
prayers  of  Christians  for  others,  offered  to 
God  in  virtue  of  their  oneness  with  Christ. 
Such  in  the  Prayer  Book  are :  the  prayers 
for  the  Queen  and  Royal  Family,  for  the 
clergy  and  people,  the  supplications  of  the 
Litany  (beginning  "We  beseech  Thee"), 
the  prayers  for  Parliament,  for  all  sorts  and 
conditions  of  men,  for  the  Church  Militant, 
&c. 

Examples  of  Intercession  are  abundant 
in  Holy  Scripture.  For  a  promise  to  Inter- 
cession specially,  see  St.  James  v.  14-18 ; 
1  St.  John  V.  16. 

INTERCESSIONS.  That  part  of  the 
Litany  in  which,  having  already  prayed  for 
ourselves,  we  proceed  to  suppUcate  God's 
mercy  for  others.  The  intercessions  are 
accompanied  by  the  response,  "We  be- 
seech thee  to  hear  us,  good  Lord"  (See 
Litany).  The  different  species  of  prayer 
are  alluded  to  by  St.  Paul,  1  Tim.  ii.  1. 
"  I  exhort,  therefore,  that  first  of  all,  suppli- 
cations, prayers,  intercessions,  and  giving  of 
thanks,  be  made  for  all  men;"  dtijo-eir, 
7rpo<rfvxir>    fvrev^ds,  ev)(apumas. 

INTERCESSOR  (See  Lord,  Jesus,  and 
Advocate).  One  who  pleads  on  behalf  of 
another.  The  title  is  applied  emphatically 
to  our  blessed  Lord,  "  who  ever  liveth  to 
make  intercession  for  us."  The  practice  of 
the  Romanists  in  investing  angels  and  de- 
parted saints  with  the  character  of  inter- 
cessors, is  rejected  as  being  unsanctioned  by 
Catholic  antiquity,  as  resting  on  no  Scriptu- 
ral authority,  and  as  being  derogatory  to 
the  dignity  of  our  Redeemer  (See  Invo- 
cation ;  Saints ;  Idolatry). 

INTERDICT.  An  ecclesiastical  censure, 
whereby  the  Church  of  Rome  forbids  the 
administration  of  the  sacraments  and  the 
performance  of  Divine  service  to  a  kingdom, 
province,  town,  &c.  Some  people  pretend 
this  custom  was  introduced  in  the  fourth  or 
fifth  century ;  but  the  opinion  that  it  began 
in  the  ninth  is  much  more  probable :  there 
are  some  instances  of  it  since  that  age,  and 
particularly  Alexander  III.,  in  1170,  super- 
ciliously put  the  kingdom  of  England  under 
an  interdict,  forbidding  the  clergy  to  perform 
any  part  of  Divine  service  except  baptism 
to  iiifants,  taking  confessions,  and  giving 
absolutions  to  dying  penitents,  which  were 
the  usual  limitations  of  an  interdict ;  Inno- 
cent III.  also  subjected  England  to  an 
interdict  in  the  reign  of  John,  but  the 
succeeding  popes  seldom  made  use  of  it. 

INTERIM     (Lat.).      The    name    of    a 


INTERMEDIATE  STATE 

formulary,  or  confession  of  faith,  obtruded 
upon  the  Protestants,  after  the  death  of 
Luther,  by  the  Emperor  Charles  V.,  when 
he  had  defeated  their  forces.  It  was  so 
called,  because  it  was  only  to  take  place  in 
the  Interim,  till  a  general  council  should, 
decide  all  the  points  in  question  between 
the  Protestants  and  Catholics.  The  occa- 
sion of  it  was  this :  the  emperor  had  made, 
choice  of  three  divines,  viz.  Julius  Pflug, 
bishop  of  Naumburg,  Michael  Sidonius, 
titular  bishop  of  Sidon,  and  John  Agricola 
of  Eisleben,  preacher  to  the  Elector  of 
Brandenburg ;  who  drew  up  a  project  con- 
sisting of  twenty-six  articles  concerning  the- 
points  of  religion  in  dispute  between  the 
Catholics  and  Protestants.  The  contro- 
verted points  were,  the  state  of  Adam  before - 
and  after  his  fall ;  the  redemption  of  man- 
kind by  Jesus  Christ ;  the  justification  of 
sins ;  charity  and  good  works ;  the  confi- 
dence we  ought  to  have  in  God,  that  our 
sins  are  remitted;  the  Church,  and  its  true- 
marks ;  its  power,  authority,  and  ministers  ; 
the  pope  and  bishops;  the  sacraments ;  the 
mass ;  the  commemoration  of  saints ;  their 
intercession ;  and  prayers  for  the  dead. 

The  emperor  sent  this  project  to  the  pope 
for  his  approbation,  which  he  refused  ^ 
whereupon  Charles  V.  published  the  imperial 
constitution  called  the  Interim,  wherein  he 
declared,  that  "  it  was  his  will,  that  all  his 
Catholic  dominions  should,  for  the  future,, 
inviolably  observe  the  customs,  statutes,, 
and  ordinances  of  the  universal  Church ; 
and  that  those  who  had  separated  them- 
selves from  it  should  either  reunite  them- 
selves to  it,  or  at  least  conform  to  this  con- 
stitution; and  that  all  should  quietly  ex- 
pect the  decisions  of  the  general  council." 
This  ordinance  was  published  in  the  Diet  of 
Augsburg,  May  15th,  1548.  But  this  device 
neither  pleased  the  pope  nor  the  Protestant ; 
the  Lutheran  preachers  openly  declared, 
they  would  not  receive  it,  alleging  that  it 
re-established  Popery.  Some  chose  rather 
to  quit  their  chairs  and  livings  than  to  sub- 
scribe it ;  nor  would  the  Duke  of  Saxony 
receive  it.  Calvin,  and  several  others,  wrote 
against  it.  On  the  other  side,  the  emperor 
was  so  severe  against  those  who  refused  to 
accept,  that  he  disfranchised  the  cities  of 
Magdeburg  and  Constance,  for  their  opposi- 
tion.— Burnet's  Reform,  ii.  177 ;  Collier, 
Ecdes.  Hist.  v.  318.  There  were  two  other 
"  Interims,"  one  of  Franconia,  the  other  of 
Leipsic. 

INTERMEDIATE  STATE.  A  term, 
made  use  of  to  denote  the  state  of  the  soul 
between  death  and  the  resurrection.  From 
the  Scriptures  speaking  frequently  of  the 
dead  sleeping  in  their  graves,  many  have 
supposed  that  the  soul  sleeps  tiU  the  resur- 
rection, i.e.  is  in  a  state  of  entire  insensibility.. 


INTINCTION 

But  against  this  opinion,  and  as  evidence 
that  the  soul,  after  death,  enters  immedi- 
ately into  a  state  of  conscious  happiness  or 
misery,  though  not  of  final  reward  or  punish- 
ment, the  following  passages  seem  to  be 
conclusive :  Matt.  xvii.  3  ;  Luke  xxiii.  43 ; 
2  Cor.  v.  6 ;  Phil.  i.  21 ;  Luke  xvi.  22,  23  ; 
Eev.  vi.  9  (See  Hell).  See  Hooker,  Serm. 
iii. ;  Bp.  Bull,  Serm.  ii.  and  iii. ;  "After 
Death,"  by  Canon  Luckock ;  and  "  Spirits 
in  Prison,"  by  Dean  Plumptre. 

INTINCTION  (intingere,  to  dip  in): 
administering  the  elements  in  the  Eucharist 
together  by  breaking  the  bread  into  the 
wine.  In  the  Eastern  Church  the  laity 
communicate  in  this  way.  The  "eucha- 
ristia  intincta"  was  forbidden  by  the  3rd 
Council  of  Braga  (c.  i.)  ;  by  Urban  II.  in  the 
11th  century;  and,  in  England,  by  the 
synod  held  at  Westminster  in  1175,  "  we 
forbid  the  Eucharist  to  be  sopped." — Hook's 
Archbishops,  ii.  p.  533 ;  Bona,  Eer.  Lit.  ii., 
xviii.  3.     [H.] 

INTONATION,  properly  speaking,  the 
recitation  by  the  chanter,  or  rector  ohori,  of 
the  commencing  words  of  the  psalm  or 
hymn,  before  the  choir  begins :  as  is  often 
practised  in  the  English  choirs,  with  respect 
to  the  Venite,  the  Te  Beum,  the  Nicene 
Creed,  and  the  Qloria  in  Excdsis.  The  in- 
tonations of  the  Gregorian  Psalm  chant  are 
regularly  prescribed.  Intoning  is  the  recita- 
tion of  the  words  to  be  used,  on  one  note  or 
tone.  Objectors  to  the  cathedral  mode  of 
service  sometimes  aver  "intoning"  to  be 
imnatural ;  but  this  objection  cannot  be 
sustained :  nor  is  there  any  reason  to  sup- 
pose that  the  revisionists  of  the  Liturgy  of 
the  16th  century  ever  intended  to  abolish 
the  immemorial  custom  of  the  Church  of 
God,  alike  in  Jewish  and  Christian  times, 
of  saying  the  Divine  service  in  some  form  of 
solemn  musical  recitative,  and  to  introduce 
the  then  unheard  of  custom  of  adopting 
the  ordinary  colloquial  tone  of  voice.  In- 
toning has  the  great  advantage  of  being 
better  heard  in  large  churches,  when  well 
done. 

INTEOIT.  In  the  ancient  Church  a 
psalm,  was  sung  or  chanted  immediately 
before  the  Collect,  Epistle,  and  Gospel.  As 
this  took  place  while  the  priest  was  entering 
within  the  septum  or  rails  of  the  altar,  it 
acquired  the  name  of  Introitus  or  Introit. 

Cardinal  Bona  says  that  Introits,  as  used 
In  the  Eoman  Church,  were  introduced  by 
Pope  Caslestme  (a.d.  422-432).  The  Introit 
consists  of  one  or  more  verses,  generally 
from  the  Psalms,  but  sometimes  from  other 
parts  of  Scripture.  This  anthem  is  the  In- 
troit, properly  so  called.  Then  follows  a 
verse  from  the  psalm  (anciently  a  whole 
psalm) :  then  the  Gloria  Patri,  after  which 
the  Introit,  or  commencing  anthem,  is  re- 


INTESTITUEE 


407 


peated.  The  First  Prayer  Book  of  Edward 
"VI.  (a.d.  1549)  appoints  special  psalms  to  be 
used  as  Introits  on  all  Sundays  and  holy- 
days.  These  differ  altogether  from  the  Koman 
Introits,  both  in  their  selection  and  in  their 
construction.  They  are  entire  psalms,  with 
the  Gloria  Patri,  and  without  any  verse. 
The  psalm  or  hymn  now  universally  sung 
in  our  churches  before  the  Communion 
Service,  may  be  said  to  represent  the  Introit, 
as  Bishop  Bull  observes.  "  In  cathedral  or 
mother  churches  there  is  still  a  decent  dis- 
tinction between  the  two  services :  for  before 
the  priest  goes  to  the  altar  to  read  the  second 
service,  there  is  a  short  but  excellent  anthem 
sung,  in  imitation  whereof  in  the  churches 
of  London,  and  in  other  greater  churches  of 
the  country,  instead  of  that  anthem  there 
is  part  of  a  psalm  sung." — Jebb's  Choral 
Service. 

In  Clifford's  Introduction  (1664)  it  ap- 
pears that  a  voluntary  at  that  time  pre- 
ceded the  Communion  Service  at  St.  Paul's. 
Shortly  after  this  time,  the  custom  arose, 
now  universal  in  choirs,  of  singing  a  Sanctus 
in  this  place  :  St.  Paul's,  Westminster,  and 
Canterbury  were  the  first  to  adopt  it.  In 
parish  churches,  a  metrical  psalm  is  fre- 
quently sung  in  this  place. 

INVENTION  OF  THE  HOLY  CEOSS. 
A  festival  appointed  to  be  observed  on  May 
3,  in  memory  of  the  day  on  which  it  is 
affirmed  our  Saviour's  cross  was  found  by 
the  empress  Helena,  in  the  time  of  Constan- 
tino the  Great  (See  Cross). 

INVESTITUEE.  In  its  first  legal  sig- 
nification this  denoted  the  transfer,  from  a 
superior  to  an  inferior,  of  a  fief;  or,  more 
generally  speaking,  of  a  property,  a  title,  a 
power,  through  the  presentation  of  certain 
symbols.  When  the  Church  was  endowed 
by  the  munificence  of  kings  and  nobles,  her 
temporal  possessions  were  regarded  as  bene- 
fices, and  the  sovereign  invested  the  eccle- 
siastic with  his  civil  rights.  He  conferred 
the  beneficium,  through  the  symbols, — to  a 
canon  of  a  book,  to  an  abbot  of  a  pastoral 
staff,  to  a  bishop  of  the  staff  and  ring.  In 
process  of  time  this  resulted  in  the  nomina- 
tion by  the  emperor,  without  the  interven- 
tion of  the  spiritual  authorities,  to  all  the 
higher  preferments  in  the  Church.  This 
grievance  Hildebrand  (Gregory  VII.)  deter- 
mined to  redress ;  but  he  aimed  not  merely 
at  reforming  a  corrupt  exercise  of  right,  but 
at  the  overthrow  of  the  right  itself.  This 
gave  rise  to  a  contest  which  lasted  for  fifty- 
six  years,  and  occasioned  sixty  battles.  It 
was  settled  by  compromise,  the  "  Concordat 
of  Worms,"  between  Henry  V.  and  Calixtus 
II.  in  1122.  The  great  quarrel  between 
Henry  I.  and  Anselm  was  on  the  ques- 
tion of  lay  investiture,  and  had  nearly 
the    same   issue. — Hook's   Archbishops,  ii. 


408 


INVISIBLES 


239   seq.  ;    StuLbs'   Mosheim,    ii.   35,    41, 
HO. 

INVISIBLES.  A  distinguisliiDg  name 
given  to  the  disciples  of  Osiander,  Flacius 
Illyricus,  Swenkfeld,  &c.,  being  so  denomi- 
nated because  tliey  denied  the  perpetual 
visibility  of  the  Church.  Palmer  remarks 
(Hist,  of  the  Church,  i.  p.  26),  that  the  re- 
formed seemed  generally  to  have  taught 
the  doctrine  of  the  visibility  of  the  Church, 
imtil  some  of  them  deemed  it  necessary, 
in  consequence  of  their  controversy  with 
the  Romanists,  who  asked  them  where  their 
Church  existed  before  Luther,  to  maintaia 
that  the  Church  might  sometimes  be  invi- 
sible. This  mistaken  view  appears  in  the 
Belgic  Confession,  and  was  adopted  by  some 
of  the  Protestants;  but  it  arose  entirely 
from  their  error  in  forsaking  the  defensive 
ground  which  their  predecessors  had  taken 
at  first,  and  placing  themselves  in  the  false 
position  of  claiming  the  exclusive  title  of 
the  Church  of  Christ,  according  to  the  ordi- 
nary signification  of  the  term.  Jurieu,  a 
minister  of  the  French  Protestants,  has 
shown  this,  and  has  endeavoured  to  prove 
that  the  Church  of  Christ  is  essentially 
visible,  and  that  it  never  remained  obscured, 
without  ministry  or  sacraments,  even  in  the 
persecutions,  or  in  the  time  of  Arianism. 
The  same  truth  has  been  acknowledged  by 
several  denominations  of  dissenters  in 
Britain. 

INVITATOBT.  Some  text  of  Scripture, 
or  short  versicle,  inviting  the  people  to  offer 
their  praise  and  adoration  to  God.  St. 
Cyril  speaks  of  an  invitatory  psalm  being 
sung  before  the  celebration  of  the  Holy 
Mysteries  (Cafec^.  Myst.  v.,  n.  17)  ;  but  the 
word  was  generally  used  for  a  short  versicle 
sung  before  the  Venite,  which  was  intended 
to  furnish  a  key-note  to  the  whole  service, 
by  indicating  to  the  congregation  the  doc- 
trine which  they  were  more  especially  to 
keep  in  mind  at  that  particular  season.  In 
the  P.  B.  of  1549,  these  invitatories  were 
omitted,  probably  because  the  Venite  is 
itself  of  a  sufficiently  invitatory  character. 
The  versicles,  however,  immediately  preced- 
ing the  Venite,  "  Praise  ye  the  Lord,"."  The 
Lord's  Name  be  praised,"  may  be  considered 
as  an  unalterable  invitatory. — Bingham,  bk. 
XV.  c.  3;  Daniel's  P.  B.  pp.  89,  90. 

INVOCATION.  The  commenciog  part 
of  the  Litany,  containing  the  invocation  of 
each  person  of  the  Godhead,  severally,  and  of 
the  Blessed  Trinity  in  Unity.  This  dis- 
tinction is  made  in  the  margin  of  NichoUs' 
edition  of  the  Common  Prayer. 

INVOCATION  OF  SAINTS.  The  thirty- 
fifth  canon  of  the  Council  of  Laodioea  (circ. 
A.D.  370)  runs  thus  :  "  It  does  not  behove 
Christians  to  leave  the  Church  of  God,  and 
go  and  mvoke    angels,  and  make  assem- 


INVOCATION  OF  SAINTS 

blies ;  which  things  are  forbidden.  If, 
therefore,  any  one  be  detected  idling  in 
their  secret  idolatry,  let  him  be  accursed, 
because  he  has  forsaken  our  Lord  Jesus 
Christ,  the  Son  of  God,  and  gone  to  idol- 
atry." This  plain  testimony  of  the  Fathers 
of  the  primitive  Church,  against  the  invo- 
cation and  worshipping  of  angels,  which  is 
denounced  as  idolatry,  is  not  to  be  set  aside 
by  all  the  ingenuity  of  the  Roman  writers. 
— See  Labbe  and  Cossart,  i.  1526.  The 
subtle  distinctions  of  Latria,  Dulia,  and  the 
rest,  had  not  entered  the  imagination  of 
Theodoret  when  he  cited  this  canon  as 
condemniug  the  worshipping  of  angels, 
trvvoSos  iv  AaoBiKfla  r^s  ^pvylas  vdfio) 
K€KQ>\vKe  TO  TQis  ayycXotff  ^po<T€v\<Ea'9aL 
(Comm.  Coloss.  ii.  18);  nor  into  that  of 
Origen,  who  expressly  says,  that  men  ought 
not  to  worship  or  adore  the  angels,  for  that 
all  prayer  and  supplication,  and  intercession 
and  thanksgiving  should  be  made  to  God 
alone  (Contra  Celsum,  v.  §  4),  and  that 
right  reason  forbids  the  invocation  of  them. 
— Ihid.  §  5. 

But  in  the  twenty-fifth  session  of  the 
Popish  Council  of  Trent,  the  synod  thus 
rules  :  "  Of  the  invocation,  veneration,  and 
relics  of  the  saints,  and  the  sacred  images, 
the  holy  synod  commands  the  bishops  and 
others  who  have  the  office  and  care  of  in- 
struction, that  according  to  the  custom  of 
the  Catholic  and  Apostolic  Church,  which 
has  been  received  from  the  first  ages  of  the 
Christian  religion,  the  consent  of  the  holy 
Fathers,  and  the  decrees  of  the  sacred 
councils,  they  make  it  a  chief  point  dili- 
gently to  instruct  the  faithful  concerning 
the  intercession  and  invocation  of  saints, 
the  honour  of  relics,  and  the  lawful  use  of 
images,  teaching  them  that  the  saints  reign- 
ing together  with  Christ  offer  to  God  their 
prayers  for  men ;  that  it  is  good  and  useful 
to  invoke  them  with  supplication,  and,  on 
account  of  the  benefits  obtained  from  God 
through  His  Son  Jesus  Christ  our  Lord,  who 
alone  is  our  Redeemer  and  Saviour,  to  have 
recourse  to  their  prayers,  aid,  and  assistance ; 
but  that  they  who  deny  that  the  saints 
enjoying  eternal  happiness  in  heaven  Sire  to 
be  invoked,  or  who  assert  either  that  they 
do  not  pray  for  men,  or  that  the  invoking 
them  that  they  may  pray  for  each  of  us,  is 
idolatry;  or  that  it  is  contrary  to  the  word 
of  God,  and  opposed  to  the  honour  of  the 
one  Mediator  between  God  and  man;  or 
that  it  is  folly,  either  by  word  or  thought,  to 
supphcate  them  who  are  reigning  in  heaven ; 
are  impious  in  their  opinions." 

All  the  researches  of  the  Roman  advo- 
cates have  not  availed  to  adduce  from 
the  early  ages  one  single  writer,  layman  or 
ecclesiastic,  who  has  enjoined  this  practice 
as  a  duty.     All  that  they  have  succeeded 


.  IRELAND 

in  showing  is,  that  in  the  course  of  the 
first  five  centuries  several  individual  writers 
are  to  he  found  who  commend  the  practice 
as  useful.  Against  these  we  will  cite  the 
following ;  and  from  a  comparison  of  the 
passages  cited  on  both  sides,  it  will  be  clear 
that  although,  notwithstanding  the  reproof 
■of  the  Apostle  (Col.  ii.  18),  the  invocation 
of  angels,  and  afterwards  of  saints,  obtained 
in  some  places  in  the  Christian  Church,  it 
was  always  an  open  question  which  men 
Avere  free  to  reject  or  not,  as  they  might 
think  fit;  and  that,  therefore,  the  Council  of 
Trent  in  the  sixt-eenth  century  was  violating 
ecclesiastical  tradition,  when  by  its  anathe- 
mas it  sought  to  abridge  Christian  liberty 
by  confirming  a  corrupt  and  foolish  custom ; 
especially  when  the  caution  of  the  Apostle 
St.  Paul  and  the  decree  of  the  Council  of 
Laodicea  are  taken  into  consideration.  It 
is  a  remarkable  thing  that,  among  all 
the  liturgies  which  Messrs.  Kirke  and 
Berrington  have  cited  in  their  volume, 
entitled,  "The  Faith  of  the  Catholics," 
Lond.  1830,  amounting  to  eleven,  only 
one  is  to  be  found,  and  that  of  the  Nes- 
torian  heretics,  containing  an  invocation 
to  a  saint  for  intercession : — thus  showing 
how  wide  a  distinction  is  to  be  drawn 
between  the  excited  expressions  of  indi- 
vidual writers,  and  the  authorised  practice 
of  the  Ctiurch.  All  the  other  liturgies  do 
no  more  than  the  Boman  canon  of  the  mass  ; 
viz.  1st,  assume,  generally,  that  the  saints 
departed  pray  for  the  saints  militant ;  and, 
2ndly,  pray  to  Grod  to  hear  their  interces- 
sions. This  is  no  more  tantamount  to  an 
invocation  of  the  saints,  than  a  prayer  to 
God  for  the  assistance  of  the  angels  would 
be  tantamount  to  a  prayer  to  the  angels 
themselves. — Perceval,  Ore  the  Soman 
Schism ;  Hook's  Church  and  her  Ordinances, 
vol.  ii.  p.  151  seq. 
IRELAND  (See  Church  of  Ireland). 
IRVINGITES.  The  followers  of  Edward 
Irving,  a  minister  of  the  Scottish  establish- 
ment, who  was  born  in  1792  and  died  in 
1834:.  In  1822,  he  was  appointed  to  a 
Scotch  Presbyterian  congregation,  and  for 
some  years  officiated  in  a  chapel  with  great 
approbation,  but  was  at  length  deposed 
from  his  ministry  by  the  presbytery,  for 
holding  a  heresy  concerning  our  Blessed 
Lord,  Whose  nature  he  considered  capable  of 
sin.  He  still  continued,  however,  to  act  as 
minister  of  a  congregation  in  London.  Both 
in  Scotland  and  in  England  he  had  many 
followers ;  and  since  his  death  Irviugism 
has  found  its  way  into  Germany  and  other 
foreign  countries.  The  first  form  which  his 
party  assumed  was  connected  with  certain 
notions  concerning  the  milleimium,  and  the 
immediately  impending  advent  of  our  Blessed 
Lord ;  and  presently  after,  as  precursors  of 


lEVINGITES 


409 


the  expected  event,  miraculous  gifts  of 
tongues,  of  prophecy,  of  healing,  and  even 
of  raising  the  dead,  were  pretended  to  by 
his  followers ;  though  Irving  himself  never 
laid  claim  to  those  more  miraculous  endow- 
ments. Superadded  to  these  notions,  was 
a  singularly  constructed  hierarchy,  of  apos- 
tles, angels,  &c.  They  aflect  the  name  of 
Apostolicals,  and  call  themselves  "  The  Ca- 
thoUc  and  Apostolic  Church."  They  have 
always  protested  against  the  application  to 
them  of  the  term  "  Irvingites,"  which  ap- 
pellation they  consider  to  be  untrue  and 
offensive,  though  derived  from  one  whom, 
when  living,  they  held  in  high  regard  as  a 
devoted  minister  of  Christ. 

"  They  do  not  profess  to  be,  and  refuse  to 
acknowledge  that  they  are,  separatists  from 
the  Church  established  or  dominant  in  the 
land  of  their  habitation,  or  from  the  general 
body  of  Christians  therein.  They  recog- 
nise the  continuance  of  the  Church  from  the 
days  of  the  first  apostles,  and  of  three  orders 
of  bishops,  priests,  and  deacons,  by  suc- 
cession from  the  apostles.  They  justify 
their  meeting  in  separate  congregations  from 
the  charge  of  schism,  on  the  ground  of  the 
same  being  permitted  and  authorised  by  an 
ordinance  of  paramount  authority,  which 
they  believe  God  has  restored  lor  the  benefit 
of  the  whole  Church.  And  so  far  from 
professing  to  be  another  sect  in  addition  to 
the  numerous  sects  dividing  the  Church,  or 
to  be  '  the  One  Church,'  to  the  exclusion  of 
all  other  bodies,  they  believe  that  their 
special  mission  is  to  re-unite  the  scattered 
members  of  the  one  body  of  Christ. 

"  The  only  standards  of  faith  which  they 
recognise  are  the  three  creeds  of  the  Catholic 
Church — the  Apostles'  Creed,  the  Nicene 
or  Constantinopolitan  Creed,  and  that  called 
the  Creed  of  St.  Athanasius.  The  speciality 
of  their  religious  belief,  whereby  they  are 
distinguished  from  other  Christian  com- 
munities, stands  in  this :  that  they  hold 
apostles,  prophets,  evangelists,  and  pastors 
to  be  abiding  ministries  in  the  Church,  and 
that  these  ministries,  together  with  the 
power  and  gifts  of  the  Holy  Ghost,  dispensed 
and  distributed  among  her  members,  are 
necessaiy  for  preparing  and  perfecting  the 
Church  for  the  second  advent  of  the  Lord ; 
and  that  supreme  rule  in  the  Church  ought 
to  be  exercised,  as  at  the  first,  by  twelve 
apostles,  not  elected  or  ordained  by  men, 
but  called  and  sent  forth  immediately  by 
God "  (See  Life  of  E.  Irving,  by  IVIrs. 
Oliphant). 

This  denomination,  of  which  there  were 
congregations  in  England,  Scotland,  Ireland, 
America,  Germany,  France  and  Switzer- 
land, at  first  made  considerable  progress ; 
but  lately  the  numbers  have  greatly  de- 
creased.    [H.] 


410 


ISAIAH 


ISAIAH,  THE  PROPHECY  OF.  A 
canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament.  Isaiah 
is  the  first  of  the  four  greater  prophets,  the 
other  three  being  Jeremiah,  Ezekiel,  and 
Daniel.  He  was  of  royal  blood,  his  father 
Amos  being  brother  to  Azariah,  king  of 
Judah.  He  prophesied  from  the  end  of  the 
reign  ot  Uzziah  to  the  time  of  Manasseh; 
by  whose  order,  according  to  a  Jewish  tra- 
dition, he  was  sawn  asunder  with  a  wooden 
saw.  He  delivered  his  predictions  under  the 
reigns  of  Uzziah,  Jotham,  Ahaz,  and  Heze- 
kiah.  The  first  five  chapters  of  his  prophecy 
relate  to  the  reign  of  Uzziah ;  the  vision  of 
the  sixth  chapter  happened  in  the  time  of 
Jotham ;  the  next  chapters,  to  the  fifteenth, 
include  his  prophecies  under  the  reign  of 
Ahaz;  and  those  that  happened  under  the 
reigns  of  Hezekiah  and  Manasseh  are  related 
in  the  next  chapters,  to  the  end. 

Besides  the  prophecies  of  Isaiah  still  ex- 
tant, he  wrote  a  book  concerning  the  actions 
of  Uzziah,  cited  in  the  Chronicles ;  but  it  is 
now  lost.  Origen,  Epiphanius,  and  St.  Je- 
rome speak  of  another  book,  called  "  The 
Ascension  of  Isaiah."  Some  of  the  Jews 
ascribe  to  him  the  Proverbs,  Bcclesiastes, 
Solomon's  Song,  and  the  Book  of  Job.  The 
most  remarkable  of  his  predictions  are  those 
concerning  the  Messiah.  He,  in  plain  terms, 
foretold,  not  only  the  coming  of  Christ  in 
the  flesh,  but  all  the  great  and  memorable 
circumstances  of  his  life  and  death.  He 
speaks,  says  St.  Jerome,  rather  of  things 
past  than  to  come ;  and  he  may  rather  be 
called  an  Evangelist  than  a  Prophet  (See 
the  Speaker's  Commentary/ :  Dditzseh,  Ein- 
leitung  in  das  Buck  Jesaia). 

ITALIC  VBESION.  A  recension  made 
in  Italy,  probably  in  the  ith  century,  of  the 
old  Latin  version  of  the  Bible  which  had 
been  made  in  the  2nd  century  in  Africa,  and 
was  in  common  use  throughout  the  Churches 
of  the  West.  The  ruggedness  of  this  version 
was  offensive  to  Italian  ears,  and  the  famili- 
arity of  some  of  the  Italian  bishops  with 
Greek  enabled  them  to  detect  errors,  and  to 
correct  them  in  the  new  translation  which 
was  made  under  their  direction.  St.  Au- 
gustine commends  the  superior  accuracy  and 
perspicuity  of  the  Italian  Version. — De  Doct. 
Christ.  15  (See  Article  on  the  Vulgate  in 
Diet,  of  the  Bible}. 


J. 

JACOBINS.  Dominicans,  sometimes 
called  Major  Friars.  In  England  they  were 
called  Black  Friars,  from  the  colour  of  their 
habit ;  and  the  part  of  London  where  they 


JAMES'S,  ST. 

first  dwelt  is  still  called  by  this  name.  The- 
name  Jacobins,  or  Jacobites,  was  given  tO' 
them  in  Prance,  because  the  first  domicile 
granted  to  them  at  Paris  was  sacred  to- 
St.  James  (Rue  de  St.  Jacques).— Stubbs' 
Mosheim,  ii.  p.  195.  A  revolutionary  club 
held  its  meetings  in  a  suppressed  convent  of 
these  Dominicans  in  Paris  a.d.  1789 ;  hence 
the  name  has  subsequently  been  applied  to- 
revolutionists  generally,  both  in  France  and- 
England.     [H.l 

JACOBITES.  I.  A  sect  of  Eastern  Chris- 
tians, so  denominated  from  Jacobus,  sur- 
named  Barad«us  (ragged-coated),  a  Syrian 
monk  and  a  disciple  of  the  school  of  Euty- 
ches  and  Dioscorus,  whose  heresy  he  spread 
so  much  in  Asia  and  Africa  in  the  sixth 
century,  that  at  last,  in  the  seventh,  the 
different  sects  of  the  Butychians  were 
swallowed  up  by  that  of  the  Jacobites,, 
which  also  comprehended  all  the  Mono- 
physites  of  the  East,  i.e.  such  as  acknow- 
ledged only  one  nature  in  Christ,  but  the 
Jacobites  themselves  affect  to  derive  their 
name  from  James  the  Lord's  brother.  Their 
head  in  Asia  is  the  patriarch  of  Antioch,  who- 
is  assisted  by  a  "  Maphrian  "  or  "  Primate 
of  the  Bast,"  who  resides  in  Mesopotamia ; 
Alexandria  is  the  see  of  the  African  one,, 
and  he  follows  the  errors  of  Dioscorus  and 
the  Cophti.  M.  Simon  relates  that  under 
the  name  of  Jacobites  must  be  included 
all  the  Monophysites  of  the  East,  whether 
Armenians,  Copts,  or  Abyssinians,  acknow- 
ledging but  one  nature  in  Christ ;  he  adds, 
the  number  of  the  Jacobites,  properly  so 
called,  is  but  small,  there  not  being  above 
thirty  or  forty  thousand  families  of  them, 
which  principally  inhabit  Syria  and  Meso- 
potamia; they  are  divided  among  them- 
selves, one  part  embracing,  and  the  other 
disowning,  the  communion  of  the  Church 
of  Eome.-^Neale's  Sist.  of  Holy  Eastern 
Church  ;  Simon's  Hist,  des  Chretiens  Orien- 
taux ;  Sim.  Asseman,  Bissertatio  de  Mono- 
physitis,  §  viii. 

II.  A  name  given  to  the  "nonjurors"  in 
England,  from  their  adherence  to  James  II. 
and  his  son.     [H.] 

JAH :  a  form  of  the  name  Jehovah  : 
which  occurs  in  the  song  of  Moses,  Exod. 
XV.  2,  and  Psa.  Ixviii.  (See  Jehovah). 

JAMES'S,  ST.,  DAY  (July  25th).  The 
day  on  which  the  Church  celebrates  the 
memory  of  the  Apostle  St.  James  the  Great, 
or  the  Elder.  He  was  one  of  the  sons  of 
Zebedee,  and  brother  of  St.  John.  He 
was  the  first  of  the  apostles  who  won  the 
crown  of  martyrdom  (Acts  xii.  2) . 

JAMES,  ST.,  THE  LESS  (See  Philip 
and  James,  SS.). 

JAMES'S,  ST.,  GENERAL  EPISTLE. 
A  canonical  book  of  the  New  Testament. 
It  was  written  by  St.  James  the  Less,  called 


JAMES,  ST. 

also  the  Lord's  brother ;  who  ^Yas  chosen  by 
the  apostles  bishop  of  Jerusalem.  The 
majority  of  modern  critics  place  the  date 
of  this  Epistle  a  little  before  the  Council 
of  Jerusalem.  St.  James  suffered  martyr- 
dom about  one  year  before  the  destruction 
of  Jerusalem,  i.e.  in  69  a.d. 

This  general  Epistle  is  addressed  to  the 
believing  Jews,  and  the  writer's  design  was 
to  comfort  them  under  the  hardships  they 
then  did,  or  shortly  were  to  suffer,  for  the 
sake  of  Christianity,  and  to  warn  and 
rebuke  those  who  had  fallen  into  dangerous 
errors  in  doctrine  and  practice.  It  is 
directed  to  the  Jews  and  Jewish  converts 
of  the  dispersion,  but  no  doubt  was  calcu- 
lated for  the  improvement  likewise  of  those 
Jews  over  whom  the  apostle  presided  in  the 
special  character  of  their  bishop. 

This  Epistle  is  the  first  of  the  Catholic  or 
General  Epistles,  in  the  canon  of  Scripture ; 
which  are  so  called,  because  they  were 
written,  not  to  one,  but  to  several  Christian 
Churches. 

JAMBS,  ST.,  LITURGY  OP.  This  is 
supposed  to  be  the  liturgy  originally  com- 
posed by  St.  James,  and  adopted  by  the 
patriarchate  at  Antioch,  which  comprised 
the  Churches  of  Palestine  and  Mesopotamia. 
There  were  inserted,  without  doubt,  many 
interpolations  in  after  times,  and  the  ques- 
tion of  its  authenticity  has  given  rise  to 
much  dispute  among  ritualists.  Allatius, 
Bona,  Bellarmine,  and  other  writers  of  that 
school,  receive  the  Liturgy  of  St.  James  of 
Jerusalem  as  genuine,  grounding  their  belief 
upon  the  unbroken  tradition  of  the  Greek 
Church,  which  always  received  it.  On  the 
other  hand.  Cardinal  Perron,  Natalis,  Alex- 
ander, Dupin,  Le  Mourry,  and  other  ritual- 
ists, reject  it  as  supposititious,  because  the 
author  quotes  passages  from  St.  Paul's 
Epistles,  which  were  not  written  in  the  life- 
time of  St.  James.  Moreover,  the  following 
prayer  is  contained  in  it: — "0  Lord  our 
God,  the  incomprehensible  Word  of  God,  of 
one  eternal  and  inseparable  substance  (ofioov- 
<riov)  with  the  Father  and  the  Holy  Ghost, 
accept  the  immortal  and  seraphic  hymn,  at 
Thy  holy  and  bloody  sacrifice":  which 
evidently  has  reference  to  that  dispute 
which  arose  on  the  Arian  controversy  (see 
Avians ;  Oreed).  But  this  may  have  been 
added  to  suit  the  exigencies  of  the  times ; 
and  if,  as  with  regard  to  the  creed,  the 
"  form  of  words"  was  handed  down  by  word 
of  mouth,  and  not  written,  it  might  be 
expected  that  there  would  be  additions  made 
according  as  there  was  requirement. 

There  are  two  forms  of  this  liturgy :  one 
in  Greek  made  up  from  two  MSS.,  of  which 
the  first  was  written  in  the  twelfth  century 
at  Antioch,  the  second  probably  at  Mount 
Sinai,  sometime  in  the  tenth  century :  the 


JANSENISTS 


411. 


other  form  is  in  Syriac,  which  is  still  used, 
by  the  Monophysites,  or  Jacobites  (see- 
Jacobites)  in  the  East.  The  similarity 
between  the  two  points  to  a  common  origin, 
and  as  there  was  no  intercommunion  between 
the  Monophysites  and  the  orthodox  after 
the  Coimcil  of  Chalcedon  in  a.d.  461,  it  is. 
evident  that  the  liturgy  was  in  existence 
before  that  date.  But  the  existing  form  is 
also  quoted  by  writers  before  that  council. 
Justin  Martyr,  a.d.  160  (^Apol.  Ixvii.),  a. 
native  of  Samaria,  gives  a  short  account 
of  the  liturgy,  which  coincides  vrith  the 
present  form,  though,  as  it  was  written  for 
the  heathen,  it  was  given  with  reserve.  St. 
Jerome,  who  quotes  words  only  used  in  the- 
Liturgy  of  St.  James  (^Comment  on  Is.  bk. 
ii.  c.  vi.),  and  Theodoret,  refer  to  it;  St. 
Cyril  describes  in  his  catechetical  lectures 
the  service  of  the  Eucharist,  as  if  he  was 
quoting  from  the  Uturgy  called  by  this 
name ;  the  writer  of  the  Apostolic  Constitu- 
tions does  the  same.  And  St.  Chrysostom's 
liturgy,  which  has  been  used  in  the  pa- 
triarchate of  Constantinople  from  time  im- 
memorial, is  based  on  that  of  St.  Basil,  and 
St.  Basil's  seems  to  have  been  based  on  that 
of  St.  James.  It  is  reasonable  to  suppose 
that  the  Liturgy  of  St.  James,  used  by  the- 
Monophysites,  and  that  used  on  the  festi- 
val of  St.  James  by  the  Greek  Christians, 
are  versions  of  that  hturgy  used  in  the 
"  parts  about  Jerusalem,"  immediately  after 
the  Apostles ;  which  was  enlarged  by  St. 
Basil  into  his  "  Mystical  Liturgy,"  as  it  was 
afterwards  called  \Oonc.  Constant,  a.d.  691), 
and  revised  by  St.  Chrysostom. — Asseman, 
God.  Liturg.  v.  68 ;  Krazer,  de  Liturgiis  ;■ 
'Rena.viiot, lAturg.  Orient.;  Migne,vol.  xxxii. 
p.  587 :  vol.  xxiv.  88 ;  Bingham,  bk.  xiii. 
5, 6 ;  Bishop  Bull,  Serm.  xiii. ;  Palmer's 
Orig.  Liturg.  i.  16-21  seq.;  Diet.  Christ. 
Ant.  (Murray),  ii.  1020.     [H.] 

JANSBNISTS:  those  who  follow  th& 
opinions  of  Jansenius,  a  doctor  of  divinity 
of  the  rmiversity  of  Louvain,  and  bishop  of 
Ypres.  I.  History.  In  the  year  1640,  the 
two  imiversities  of  Louvain  and  Douay 
found  it  necessary  to  condemn  the  loose 
doctrine  of  the  Jesuits,  particularly  Bather 
Molina  and  Bather  Leonard  Celsus,  con- 
cerning grace  and  predestination.  This 
having  set  the  controversy  on  foot,  Jan- 
senius opposed  to  the  doctrine  of  the  Jesuits 
the  sentiments  of  St.  Augustine,  and  wrote 
a  treatise  upon  grace,  which  he  entitled 
Augustinus.  It  was  condemned  by  Pope 
Urban  VIII.  in  1642  ;  but  this  did  not  put  an 
end  to  the  controversy,  and  many  polemical 
writings  concerning  Orace  were  published. 
Amauld,  Principal  of  Port  Eoyal,  wrote  a 
defence  of  the  "  Augustinus,"  and  Carnet, 
syndic  of  the  Theological  Faculty  at  Paris,, 
drew  up  five  articles,  which  however  the- 


412 


JANSENISTS 


Jansenists  afterwards  repudiated,  denying 
that  they  were  derived  from  the  "  Augus- 
tinus."    They  were : — 

1.  Some  of  God's  commandments  are 
impossible  to  be  kept  by  the  righteous, 
•even  though  they  are  willing  to  observe 
them. 

2.  A  man  doth  never  resist  inward  grace, 
in  the  state  of  fallen  nature. 

3.  In  order  to  merit,  or  not  merit,  it  is 
not  necessary  that  a  man  should  have  a 
liberty  free  from  necessity.  It  is  suflS.- 
<!ient  that  he  hath  a  liberty  free  from  re- 
straint. 

4.  The  Semi-Pelagians  were  heretics, 
because  they  asserted  the  necessity  of  an 
inward  preventing  grace  for  eveiy  action. 

5.  It  is  a  Semi-Pelagian  opinion  to  say, 
that  Jesus  Christ  died  for  all  mankind, 
without  exception. 

In  1653,  a  bull  of  condemnation  was 
issued  by  Pope  Innocent  X. ;  and  three 
years  later,  Alexander  VII.  denounced  the 
five  articles  in  another  buU.  In  the  mean- 
time Pascal  had  produced  the  famous  "  Pro- 
vincial Letters  "  in  defence  of  "  Messieurs  de 
Port-Boyal,"  who  were  looked  upon  as  the 
bulwark  of  Jansenism  (See  Hallam's  Introd. 
1650 ;  Macaulay's  Eist.  vi.).  The  Reflexions 
Morales  of  Quesnel,  and  the  consequent 
spread  of  Jansenism,  caused  Louis  XIV., 
iinder  the  influence  of  the  Jesuits,  to  solicit 
a  public  condemnation  from  the  Pope 
Clement  XI. ;  the  result  of  which  was  the 
celebrated  bull  "  Unigenitus,"  so  called  from 
its  begirming  with  the  words  "  Unigenitus 
Dei  Filius."  Persecution  followed;  those 
who  preferred  exile  to  subscription  found 
a  home  in  another  land  than  France  (Eanke, 
Eist.  of  Popes,  viii.  18).  The  United  Pro- 
vinces in  Holland  had  become  Calvinist ; 
but  Utrecht  and  Haarlem  remained  in  the 
Roman  communion.  Peter  Codde,  arch- 
bishop of  Sebaste,  who  resided  at  Utrecht, 
a  friend  of  Arnauld,  had  been  denounced 
as  a  Jansenist ;  and  to  Utrecht  the  refugees 
went,  and  were  received  into  communion. 
There  Jansenism  stUl  exists. 

II.  Doctrine.  The  following  are  the  de- 
ductions of  Jan  sen  from  Augustine :  Man 
was  created  perfect  in  his  nature,  though 
capable  of  corruption:  his  will  was  free, 
though  subordinate  to  the  will  of  God,  as 
love  is  subordinate  to  its  object.  After 
the  Fall  this  freedom  became  a  mere  form ; 
abstention  from  sin  is  simply  from  fear,  or 
pride,  or  constitutional  despotism.  Per- 
formance of  good  is  in  opposition  to  man's 
will.  This  depraved  condition  can  only  be 
remedied  by  the  grace  of  Christ,  which 
infuses  a  divine  saving  principle  into  the 
life  of  man,  sets  free  the  fettered  will,  and 
gives  him  strength.  This  grace  acts  with 
irresistible  energy,  and  is  always  effectual. 


JEREMAH 

It  supersedes  that  unreal  freedom  of  will 
that  came  in  with  the  Fall,  for  grace  alone 
is  freedom,  the  converse  of  all  external 
compulsion.  All  those  shall  be  saved  who 
are  predestined  to  salvation  from  all  eternity; 
only  for  these  did  Christ  die.  This  gift  of 
grace  manifests  its  inward  presence  by 
sensations  of  spiritual  joy,  as  being  the  very 
indwelling  of  the  Deity.— Stubbs'  Mosheim, 
iii.  pp.  276-280  &  476-478;  Broughton, 
Bihlio.  vol.  i. ;  Tregelles,  Jansenists ;  Pascal's 
Lettres  Provinciales ;  Bayle's  Diet.  s.  v. 
Jansenius. 

JEHOVAH  (nin)).  One  of  the  names 
given  in  Scripture  to  Almighty  God,  and 
pecuhar  to  Him,  signifying  the  Being  who  is 
self-existent,  and  gives  existence  to  others. 

The  name  is  also  given  to  our  Blessed 
Saviour,  and  is  a  proof  of  his  Godhead 
(Compare  Isaiah  xi.  3,  with  Matt.  iii.  3,  and 
Isaiah  vi.,  with  John  xii.  41).  The  Jews 
had  so  great  a  veneration  for  this  name,  that 
they  left  off  the  custom  of  pronouncing  it, 
whereby  its  true  pronunciation  was  for- 
gotten. It  is  called  the  Tetragrammaton 
(^(TpaypajifixiTov),  or  name  of  four  letters, 
containing  in  itself  the  past  and  future 
tenses,  as  well  as  the  present  participle, 
and  signifies.  He  who  was,  is,  and  shall 
he ;  i.e.  the  Eternal,  the  Unchangeable,  the 
Faithful. 

The  same  veneration  seems  to  have  ac- 
tuated most  Christian  communities  in  their 
translation  of  the  word,  rendered  in  Greek 
by  Kupiof,  in  Latin  by  Dominus,  and  in 
English  by  Lord.  The  word  Jehovah 
occurs  but  four  times  simply,  and  five  times 
in  composition,  in  our  authorised  transla- 
tion. 

JEJUNIA  QUATUOR  TBMPORUM: 
the  fasts  of  the  four  seasons  (See  Ertiber 
Days). 

JEREMIAH,  THE  PROPHECY  OP. 
A  canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament. 
This  divine  writer  was  of  the  race  of  the 
priests,  the  son  of  Hilkiah  of  Anathoth,  in 
the  tribe  of  Benjamin.  He  was  called  to 
the  prophetic  office  when  he  was  very 
young,  about  the  thirteenth  year  of  Josiah, 
and  continued  in  the  discharge  of  it  above 
forty  years.  He  was  not  carried  captive  to 
Babylon  with  the  other  Jews,  but  remained 
in  Judea,  to  lament  the  desolation  of  his 
country.  He  was  afterwards  a  prisoner  in 
Egypt,  with  his  disciple  Baruch,  where  it  is 
supposed  he  died  in  a  very  advanced  age. 
Some  of  the  Christian  Fathers  tell  us  he  was 
stoned  to  death  by  the  Jews  for  preaching 
against  their  idolatry;  and  some  say  he 
was  put  to  death  by  Pharaoh  Hophra, 
because  of  his  prophecy  against  him. 

Part  of  the  prophecy  of  Jeremiah  relates 
to  the  time  after  the  captivity  of  Israel,  and 


JEEOME,  ST. 

before  tliat  of  Judah,  from  the  first  cliapter 
to  the  forty-fourth ;  and  part  of  it  was  in 
the  time  of  the  latter  captivity,  from  the 
forty-fom-th  chapter  to  the  end.  The 
prophet  lays  open  the  sins  of  the  kingdom 
of  J  udah  with  great  freedom  and  boldness, 
and  reminds  them  of  the  severe  judgments 
which  had  befallen  the  ten  tribes  for  the 
same  offences ;  he  passionately  laments  their 
misfortune,  and  recommends  a  speedy  refor- 
mation to  them.  Afterwards  he  predicts 
the  grievous  calamities  that  were  approach- 
ing, particularly  the  seventy  years'  captivity 
in  Chaldea.  He  likewise  foretells  their 
deliverance  and  happy  return,  and  the 
recompence  which  Babylon,  Moab,  and 
other  enemies  of  the  Jews,  should  meet  with 
in  due  time.  There  are  likewise  several 
intimations  in  this  prophecy  concerning  the 
kingdom  of  the  Messiah ;  also  several 
remarkable  visions  and  types,  and  historical 
passages  relating  to  those  times. 

The  fifty-second  chapter  does  not  belong 
to  the  prophecy  of  Jeremiah,  which  con- 
cludes, at  the  end  of  the  fifty-first  chapter, 
with  these  words  :  "  Thus  far  are  the  words 
of  Jeremiah."  The  last,  or  fifty-second 
chapter  (which  probably  was  added  by 
Ezra),  contains  a  narrative  of  the  taking  of 
Jerusalem,  and  of  what  happened  during 
the  captivity  of  the  Jews  in  Babylon,  to  the 
death  of  Jechonias.  St.  Jerome  has  observed 
upon  this  prophet,  that  his  style  is  more 
easy  than  that  of  Isaiah  and  Hosea ;  that 
he  retains  something  of  the  rusticity  of  the 
village  where  he  was  bom ;  but  that  he  is 
very  learned  and  majestic,  and  equal  to 
those  two  prophets  in  the  sense  of  his 
prophecy  (See  Speaker's  Commentary). 

JEEOME,  ST.:  Priest,  Confessor,  and 
Doctor:  was  one  of  the  four  great  Latin 
Fathers.  He  was  bom  at  Stridonium  in 
Dalmatia,  near  Aquileia,  and  in  his  early 
years  studied  law  at  Rome.  Being  baptized 
when  thirty  years  of  age,  he  determined  to 
devote  himself  to  good  works,  and  to  per- 
petual celibacy.  He  went  to  the  East,  and 
in  a  desert  place  near  Chalcis,  he  spent  four 
years  in  study  and  seclusion  as  an  Anchorite. 
He  afterwards  gained  great  influence  over 
both  clergy  and  laity  in  the  East,  inducing 
them  to  exercise  greater  abstinence  and 
simplicity  in  their  ways  of  life.  His  fame 
preceded  him  to  Kome,  where  for  three  years 
he  laboured  hard,  and  did  a  great  work. 
Among  his  converts  was  Paula,  a  descendant 
of  the  Scipios  and  the  Gracchi,  and  Marcella 
who  founded  religious  houses  for  women. 
Leaving  Eome  after  a  ministry  of  three 
years,  he  settled  at  Bethlehem,  where  he 
had  foimded  a  monastery.  The  work  for 
which  he  is  now  best  known,  is  the  transla- 
tion of  the  Scriptures  into  Latin,  which 
formed  the  basis  of  the  Vulgate.     He  died 


JESUITS 


413, 


in  A.D.  420;  and  is  commemorated  in  our 
Calendar  on  Sept.  30. — Diet  Eccles.  Bioq 
(Murray)  ;  Blunt's  P.  B.  i.  [55].     [H.] 

JERUSALEM,  LITURGY  OF  (See 
James,  St.,  Liturgy  of). 

JESUITS,  or  the  SOCIETY  OP  JESUS. 
A  society  which,  at  one  period,  extended  its 
influence  to  the  very  ends  of  the  earth,  and- 
proved  the  main  pillar  of  the  papal  hierarchy, 
— which  wormed  itself  into  almost  absolute 
power,  occupying  the  high  places,  and  lead- 
ing captive  the  ecclesiastical  dictator  of  the 
world, — must  be  an  object  of  great  interest 
to  all  who  study  ecclesiastical  history. 

1.  Ignatius  Loyola,  a  native  of  Biscay,  is 
well  known  to  have  been  the  founder  of 
this,  nominally,  religious  order.  He  was 
born  in  1491,  and  became  first  a  page  to 
Ferdinand  V.,  king  of  Spain,  and  then  an 
officer  in  his  army.  In  1521  he  was  wounded 
in  both  legs  at  the  siege  of  Pampeluna, 
when  having  had  leisure  to  study  a  book  of 
Lives  of  the  Saints,  he  devoted  himself  to 
the  service  of  the  Virgin ;  and  his  military 
ardour  becoming  metamorphosed  into  super- 
stitious zeal,  he  went  on  a  pilgrimage  into 
the  Holy  Land.  Upon  his  return  to  Europe, 
he  studied  in  the  universities  of  Spain, 
whence  he  removed  into  France,  and  formed 
a  plan  for  the  institution  of  this  new  order, 
which  he  presented  to  the  pope.  But,  not- 
withstanding the  high  pretensions  of  Loyola 
to  inspiration,  Paul  III.  refused  his  request, 
till  his  scruples  were  removed  by  an  irresist- 
ible argument  addressed  to  his  self-interest : 
it  was  proposed  that  every  member  should 
make  a  vow  of  unconditional  obedience  to 
the  pope,  without  requiring  any  support 
from  the  holy  see.  The  order  was  instituted 
in  1540,  andLoyola  appointed  to  be  the  first 
general. 

The  plan  of  the  society  was  completed  by 
the  two  immediate  successors  of  the  founder, 
Lainez  and  Aquaviva,  both  of  whom  excelled 
their  master  in  ability  and  the  science  of 
government ;  and,  in  a  few  years,  the  society 
established  itself  in  every  Catholic  country, 
acquiring  prodigious  wealth,  and  exciting 
the  apprehensions  of  all  the  enemies  of  the 
Roman  faith. 

To  Lainez  are  ascribed  the  Seereta  Monita, 
or  secret  instructions  of  the  order;  which 
were  first  discovered  when  Christian,  Duke 
of  Brunswick,  seized  the  Jesuits'  college  at 
Paderbom,  in  WestphaUa,  at  which  time  he 
gave  their  books  and  manuscripts  to  the 
Capuchins,  who  found  these  secret  instruc- 
tions among  the  archives  of  their  rector. 
After  this,  another  copy  was  detected  at 
Prague,  in  the  college  of  the  Jesuits. 

In  Portugal,  where  the  Jesuits  were  first 
received,  they  obtained  the  support  of  the 
court,  which  for  many  years  delivered  to 
them  the  consciences  of  its  princes  and  the 


414 


JESUITS 


education  of  the  people.  Portugal  opened 
the  door  to  their  missions,  and  gave  them 
estahlishments  in  Asia,  Africa,  and  America. 
They  usurped  the  sovereignty  of  Paraguay, 
and  resisted  the  forces  of  Portugal  and  Spain, 
who  claimed  it.  The  court  of  Lisbon,  and 
even  Eome  herself,  protested  in  vain  against 
their  excesses.  The  league  in  Prance  was, 
in  reaUty,  a  conspiracy  of  the  Jesuits,  under 
the  sanction  of  Sixtus  V.,  to  disturb  the 
succession  to  the  throne  of  France.  The 
•Jesuits'  college  at  Paris  was  the  grand  focus 
of  the  seditions  and  treasons  which  then 
agitated  the  state,  and  the  ruler  of  the 
•Jesuits  was  president  of  the  Council  of 
Sixteen,  which  gave  the  impulse  to  the 
leagues  formed  there  and  throughout  Prance. 
Matthieu,  a  Jesuit  and  confessor  of  Henry 
III.,  was  called  "  the  Courier  of  the  League," 
•on  account  of  his  frequent  journeys  to  and 
from  Borne  at  that  disastroxis  period. 

In  Germany  the  society  appropriated  the 
^  richest  benefices,  particidarly  those  of  the 
monasteries  of  St.  Benedict  and  St.  Bernard. 
-  Catherine  of  Austria  confided  in  them,  and 
was  supplanted ;  and  loud  outcries  were 
uttered  against  them  by  the  sufferers  in 
Vienna,  in  the  states  of  Styria,  Carinthia, 
Camiola,  and  elsewhere.  Their  cruelties  in 
Poland  ■(vill  never  be  forgotten.  They  were 
expelled  from  Abyssinia,  Japan,  Malta, 
-  ■Cochin,  Moscow,  Venice,  and  other  places, 
for  their  gross  misconduct ;  and  in  America 
and  Asia  they  carried  devastation  and  blood 
wherever  they  went.  The  great  object  of 
the  persecution  of  the  Protestants  in  Savoy 
was  the  confiscation  of  their  property,  in 
order  to  endow  the  colleges  of  the  Jesuits. 
They  had,  no  doubt,  a  share  in  the  atrocities 
of  the  Duke  of  Alva  in  the  Low  Countries. 
They  boasted  of  the  friendship  of  Catherine 
■de  Medicis,  who  espoused  their  cause,  and 
imder  whose  influence  the  massacre  of  St. 
Bartholomew  was  executed.  Louis  XIV. 
had  three  Jesuit  confessors,  which  may 
explain  the  revocation  of  the  edict  of 
Nantes. 

The  Jesuits  have  been  notorious  for  at- 
tempting the  lives  of  princes.  The  reign 
of  Queen  Elizabeth  presents  a  succession 
of  plots.  In  her  proclamation,  dated  Nov. 
15,  1602,  she  says,  that  "  the  Jesiiits  had 
fomented  the  plots  against  her  person, 
excited  her  subjects  to  revolt,  provoked 
foreign  princes  to  compass  her  death,  en- 
gaged in  all  affairs  of  state,  and  by  their 
language  and  writings  had  undertaken  to 
dispose  of  her  crown." 

Lucius  enumerates  five  conspiracies  of 
the  Jesuits  against  James  I.  before  he  had 
reigned  a  year.  They  contrived  the  Gun- 
powder Plot  (Osborne's  Secret  Hist,  of 
Court  of  James  I.  p.  ■448).  So  late  as  the 
time  of  George  I.,  both  houses  of  parliament 


JESUITS 

reported,  that  the  evidence  examined  by 
them  on  the  conspiracy  of  Plunket  and 
Layer  had  satisfactorily  shown  that  it  had 
for  its  object  the  destruction  of  the  king, 
the  subversion  of  the  laws,  and  the  crown- 
ing of  the  Popish  Pretender;  and  they 
state  that  "Plunket  was  bom  at  Dublin, 
and  bred  up  at  the  Jesuits'  college  at 
Vienna."  Henry  III.  of  Prance  was  as- 
sassinated by  Clement,  a  Jesuit,  in  1589. 
The  Jesuits  murdered  WOliam,  prince  of 
Orange,  in  1584.  They  attempted  the  life 
of  Louis  XV.  for  imposing  silence  on  the 
polemics  of  their  order,  and  were  also  guilty 
of  innumerable  other  atrocities. 

The  pernicious  spirit  and  constitution  of 
this  order  rendered  it  early  detested  by  the 
principal  powers  of  Europe;  and  while 
Pascal,  by  his  "  Provincial  Letters,"  exposed 
the  morality  of  the  society,  and  thus  over- 
threw their  influence  over  the  multitude, 
different  potentates  concurred,  from  time  to 
time,  to  destroy  or  prevent  its  establish- 
ments. Charles  V.  opposed  the  order  in  his 
dominions  :  it  was  expelled  in  England  by 
the  proclamation  of  James  I.  in  1604 ;  in 
Venice,  in  1606 ;  in  Portugal,  in  1759 ;  in 
Prance,  in  1764;  in  Spain  and  Sicily,  in 
1767,  and  suppressed  and  abolished  by  Pope 
Clement  XIV.  in  1775.  Our  own  age  has 
witnessed  its  revival,  and  is  even  now 
suffering  from  the  increased  energy  of  its 
members. 

II.  The  Jesuits  are  taught  to  consider 
themselves  as  formed  for  action,  in  oppo- 
sition to  the  monastic  orders,  who  retire 
from  the  concerns  of  the  world ;  and  so  they 
engage  in  all  civil  and  commercial  trans- 
actions, insinuate  themselves  into  the 
friendship  of  persons  of  rank,  study  the 
disposition  of  all  classes,  with  a  view  of 
obtaining  an  influence  over  them,  and  • 
undertake  missions  to  distant  nations.  It 
is  an  essential  principle  of  their  pohoy,  by 
every  means,  to  propagate  Roman  doctrines, 
and  extend  the  power  of  the  Eoman  Church. 
No  labour  is  spared,  no  intrigue  omitted, 
that  may  prove  conducive  to  this  purpose. 

The  constitution  of  the  society  is  mon- 
archical. A  general  is  chosen  for  life  by 
deputies  from  the  several  provinces.  His 
power  is  supreme  and  universal.  Every 
member  is  at  his  entire  disposal,  and  is 
required  to  submit  his  wUl  and  sentiments 
to  his  dictation,  and  to  Hsten  to  his  in- 
junctions, as  if  uttered  by  Christ  himself. 
The  fortunei,  person,  and  conscience  of  the 
whole  society  are  at  his  disposal,  and  he  can 
dispense  his  order  not  only  from  the  vows 
of  poverty,  chastity,  and  monastic  obedience, 
but  even  from  submission  to  the  pope 
whenever  he  pleases.  He  nominates  and 
removes  provincials,  rectors,  professors,  and 
all  ofiicers  of  the  order,  superintends  the 


JESUITESSES 

universities,  houses,  and  missions,  decides 
■controversies,  and  forms  or  dissolves  con- 
tracts. No  member  can  express  any 
opinion  of  his  own ;  and  the  society  has 
had  its  prisons,  independent  of  the  secular 
authority. 

There  are  four  classes  of  members, — the 
novitiates  or  probationers,  the  approved 
-disciples,  the  coadjutors,  and  the  professors 
■of  the  four  vows.  The  education  of  youth 
was  always  considered  by  them  as  their 
peculiar  province, — aware  of  the  influence 
which  such  a  measure  would  infallibly 
■secure  over  another  generation ;  and  before 
the  conclusion  of  the  sixteenth  century  the 
■Jesuits  had  obtained  the  chief  direction  of 
-the  youthful  mind  in  every  Boman  Catholic 
•country  in  Europe.  They  had  become  the 
-confessors  of  almost  all  its  m.onarchs,  and 
the  spiritual  guides  of  nearly  every  person 
•distinguished  for  rank  or  influence.  At 
■different  periods  they  obtained  the  direction 
•of  the  most  considerable  courts,  and  took 
part  in  every  intrigue  and  revolution. 

Notwithstanding  their  vow  of  poverty, 
■they  accumulated,  upon  various  pretences, 
limmense  wealth.  They  claimed  exemption 
from  tithes  under  a  bull  of  Gregory  XIIL, 
who  was  devoted  to  their  interests;  and 
by  obtaining  a  special  licence  from  the 
•court  of  Eome  to  trade  vrith  the  nations 
■whom  they  professed  to  convert,  they  car- 
ried on  a  lucrative  commerce  in  the  East 
and  "West  Indies,  formed  settlements  in 
'difierent  countries,  and  acquired  possession 
of  a  large  province  in  South  America 
(Paraguay),  where  they  reigned  as  sove- 
reigns over  some  hundred  thousand  sub- 
jects. Pius  IX.,  under  whom  the  tempo- 
jral  sovereignty  came  to  an  end,  was  noto- 
riously under  their  influence ;  and  it  has 
been  remarked  that  Jesuit  influence  has 
always  ended  unluckily,  however  success- 
ful it  may  have  been  for  a  time. 

Their  poUcy  is  uniformly  to  inculcate 
■attachment  to  the  Order,  and  by  a  pHant 
morality  to  soothe  and  gratify  the  passions 
■of  mankind,  for  the  purpose  of  securing 
their  patronage.  They  proclaim  the  duty 
•of  opposing  princes  who  are  inimical  to  the 
Boman  faith,  and  have  employed  every 
weapon,  every  artful  and  every  intolerant 
jneasure,  to  resist  the  progress  of  the  Be- 
fonned  Church. — Cahour,  "  Les  Jesuites  par 
■un  Jesuit ; "  Hallam's  Introd.  to  Lit.  of 
Eur.,  1650-1700 ;  Macaulay,  E.  E.  1686  ; 
Eanke's  Hist,  of  Popes ;  Guizot,  Hist,  de 
la  Givil.,  sect.  xii. ;  Cartwright's  Hist,  of 

.fjfi<i1/,%fft    oZC 

JESUITESSES.  An  order  of  nuns, 
who  had  convents  ia  Italy  and  Elanders. 
They  followed  the  Jesuit  rules ;  and  though 
iheir  order  was  not  approved  at  Bome,  yet 
they    had    several    convents,  where    they 


JESUS 


«5 


had  a  lady  abbess,  who  took  the  Jesuit 
vows  of  poverty,  chastity,  and  obedience. 
They  did  not  confine  themselves  to  their 
cloisters,  but  went  abroad  and  preached. 
They  were  two  English  young  women, 
who,  by  the  instigation  of  Father  Gerard, 
set  up  this  order,  intending  it  for  the  use  of 
missionaries  into  England.  This  order  was 
suppressed  by  a  bull  of  Pope  Urban  VIII., 
A.D.  1630. 

JESUS  is  the  same  with  the  Hebrew 
name  Joshua,  or  JehoshxM,  i.e.  Jehovah 
the  Saviour.  As  the  name  Jesus  was  given 
to  the  Blessed  Lord  by  Divine  command,  so 
was  the  name  of  the  son  of  Nun  changed 
by  Moses  from  Hoshea  to  Joshua,  the 
Saviour;  he  being  a  type  of  our  Blessed 
Lord  (Num.  xiii.  16)  (See  Christ, 
Messiah,  Lord),  the  name  that  was  given 
by  the  Divine  command  to  the  Saviour  of 
the  world-  He  Ls  called  Christ  (anointed), 
because  He  was  anointed  to  the  mediatorial 
office,  and  Jesus  (Saviour),  because  He  came 
to  save  his  people  from  their  sins. 

We  are  to  regard  Him,  as  He  is  our 
Saviour.  I  will  place  salvation  in  Jesus 
"the  Saviour"  (Phil.  iii.  20),— thus  de- 
clared by  prophecy  (Isa.  xix.  20),  and  for 
this  reason  so  expressly  called  (St.  Matt.  i. 
21 ;  St.  Luke  i.  31),  and  the  prophecies 
truly  fulfilled  (St.  Luke  ii.  11 ;  Acts  v.  31, 
xiii.  23),  is  "the  Saviour  of  the  world" 
(St.  John  iv.  42  ;  iii.  17 ;  1  St.  John  iv.  14), 
"the  Saviour  of  all  men"  (1  Tim.  iv.  10; 
St.  Luke  ix.  56;  St.  John  xii.  47),  who 
"  came  into  the  world  to  save  sinners "  (1 
Tim.  i.  15 ;  St.  Luke  v.  32 ;  Bom.  v.  8 ; 
1  St.  John  iii.  5),  "the  Lord  and  Saviour" 
(2  St.  Pet.  iL  20 ;  iii.  2),  "  the  captain  of 
their  salvation "  (Heb.  ii.  10).  And  He  is 
revealed  as  the  only  way  to  salvation  thus 
predicted  (Isa.  xxxv,  8 ;  xlix.  6 ;  Ii.  5 ; 
ILx.  16 ;  Ixiii.  1 ;  Joel  ii.  32 ;  St.  Matt.  i.  21 ; 
Acts  iv.  12;  Heb.  ix.  8), — so  by  Himself 
declared  (St.  Matt,  xviii.  11 ;  St.  Luke  xix. 
9), — and  by  those  speaking  through  the  in- 
spiration of  the  Holy  Spirit  (St.  Luke  i.  69, 
with  67 ;  ii.  30,  with  26,  27 ;  Acts  ii.  21 ; 
Eph.  ii.  18). 

He  was  sent  by  God  for  this  purpose 
(St.  John  in.  17 ;  Acts  v.  31,  xiii.  23 ;  1 
St.  John  iv.  14),  and  is  declared  to  be  "  the 
author  of  eternal  salvation  unto  all  them 
that  obey  him  "  (Heb.  v.  9 ;  Isa.  Ii.  6,  8),— 
that  "  confess  "  Him  (Bom.  x.  9),  "  believe 
on  "  Him  (Bom.  x.  9 ;  Eph.  ii.  8 ;  Acts  xvi. 
31;  X.  43),  and  "call  on  the  name  of  the 
Lord  "  (Acts  ii.  21), — "  to  the  Jews  first " 
(Bom.  i.  16 ;  Isa.  xlv.  17 ;  xlvi.  13  ;  Ixii.  1, 
11;  Jer.  xxxiii.  15,  16;  Zech.  ix.  9;  St. 
Luke  i.  69,  77 ;  Acts  xi.  19 ;  xv.  11 ;  xiii. 
23,  46),  "and  also  to  the  Greek"  (Bom.  i. 
16),— the  Gentiles  (Isa.  xlv.  22  ;  xlix.  6 ; 
Ii.  5 ;  Iii.  10 ;  St.  Luke  iii.  6 ;  Acts  xxviii. 


416 


JESUS 


28 ;   Eom.  iii.  29 ;  x.  12 ;  xv.  16 ;  Gal.  iii. 
28 ;  Col.  iii.  11). 

To  "  that  blessed  hope "  we  now  look 
(Tit.  ii.  13),  through  "  the  righteousness  of 
God  and  our  Saviour "  (2  St.  Pet.  i.  1), — 
"  our  Saviour  Jesus  Christ  "  (2  Tim.  i.  10  ; 
Tit.  i.  4 ;  iii.  6).  Our  salvation  has  been 
effected  by  the  sacrifice  of  Himself;  "in 
Him  have  we  redemption — the  forgiveness 
of  sins;"  not  purchased  "with  corruptible 
things,"  but  with  His  own  "  precious  blood  " 
(Eph.  i.  7 ;  1  St.  Pet.  i.  18, 19),  for  "  He  gave 
Himself  a  ransom  for  all"  (1  Tim.  ii.  6). 
And  thus  having  made  "  peace  through  the 
blood  of  His  cross,"  He  has  "reconciled  both  " 
— Jews  and  Gentiles — "unto  God  in  one 
body  "  (Col.  i.  20 ;  Eph.  ii.  16)  (See  Bowing 
at  the  Name  of  Jesus).  Joshua,  the  successor 
of  Moses,  is  called  Jesus  in  the  authorised 
translation  of  the  New  Testament,  Acts  vii. 
54,  and  Heb.  iv.  8.  Both  names  are  the 
same  in  the  LXX.  and  the  Greek  Testament. 
JESUS,  NAME  OF.  A  minor  holy-day, 
observed  in  our  Calendar  on  August  7.  This 
was  held  in  the  early  English  Church  on  the 
Esast  of  the  Circumcision :  in  the  Roman 
Church  it  is  observed  on  the  second  Sunday 
after  Epiphany.  There  is  no  account  of 
the  origin  of  tbis  festival. — ^B.  Daniel,  P.  B. 
p.  68.     [H.] 

JEWS.  The  general  name  given  to  the 
descendants  of  Abraham,  though  in  strict- 
ness it  originally  belonged  only  to  the  tribes 
of  Judah  and  Benjamin,  with  the  Levites 
settled  among  them,  who  constituted  the 
kingdom  of  Judah.  For  the  early  history 
of  the  Jews  we  need  only  refer  to  the  Old 
Testament.  At  the  time  of  our  Lord's  com- 
ing in  the  iiesh,  Herod,  called  "  the  Great," 
was  king  of  the  Jews,  but  he  and  his  suc- 
cessors were  really  only  lieutenants  of  the 
lioman  emperor,  and  Palestine  was  a  Koman 
province.  Under  this  bondage  the  people 
chafed,  and  Ihey  were  aroused,  to  frequent 
insurrections  by  the  rapacity  of  the  Roman 
governors  in  the  time  of  Herod  Agrippa.  It 
was  probably  on  account  of  this  state  of 
things  that  so  many  Jews  left  their  country 
and  settled  elsewhere.  There  were  numbers 
of  them  in  Egypt,  and  in  the  towns  of  Asia. 
From  the  Acts  of  the  Apostles  we  learn  that 
there  were  Jews  settled  in  every  town  to 
which  St.  Paul  went ;  a  letter  of  Philo  to 
Agrippa  speaks  of  the  numerous  settlements 
of  the  Jews  in  various  countries ;  and 
Cicero  {Pro  Flacco)  mentions  a  wealthy 
community  of  them  in  Italy  {Oonyheare  and 
Jlowson).  But  the  destruction  of  Jerusalem, 
A.D.  70,  caused  the  great  dispersion  of  the 
Jews,  and  from  that  time  they  were  scat- 
tered amongst  many  nations,  amassing 
wealth  by  their  commercial  industry  and 
business  habits,  but  subject  to  great  perse- 
cutions.     The  emperors    alternately    pro- 


JEWS 

tected  and  persecuted  them ;  and  this  was 
their  fate  throughout  the  early  and  middle 
ages.  Charles  the  Great,  for  instance,  en- 
couraged them;  they  were  allowed  to  fill 
municipal  offices  ;  and  this  continued  under 
succeeding  reigns.  But  Philip  Augustus 
confiscated  all  their  property,  and  expelled 
them  from  his  dominions  a.d.  1182.  They 
were  afterwards  readmitted,  but  only  to 
undergo  the  same  treatment  from  Charles 
VII.  A.D.  1394.  Similar  acts  of  oppression 
took  place  in  other  countries,  notably  in 
Spain,  from  whence  500,000  Jews  were 
expelled,  shortly  after  the  expulsion  of  the- 
Moors.  They  were  expelled  from  England 
by  Edward  I.  1290,  and  did  not  return  tUl 
1660.  There  were  in  most  countries  re- 
strictions laid  upon  the  Jews,  but  in  later 
times  these  have  been  generally  removed, 
except  in  Russia ;  where,  however,  there  are- 
more  than  1,000,000  Jews.  In  England 
Jews  were  admitted  to  the  elective  fran- 
chise in  1832 ;  and  made  eligible  to  all 
municipal  offices  in  1845  (8  &  9  Vict.  c. 
59);  their  places  of  worship  were  placed 
on  the  same  footing  as  those  of  Romanists 
and  Dissenters  in  1855 ;  and  in  1858  they 
were  admitted  to  Parliament.  There  are 
altogether  some  8,000,000  Jews,  of  whom 
42,000  are  in  England,  with  about  seventy 
synagogues.  It  is  estimated  that  every 
year  1200  to  1500  Jews  leave  the  synagogue 
for  the  Church  of  Christ  {Official  Year- 
Book  of  the  Church  of  England,  1886). 

II.  The  creed  of  the  Jews  consists  of 
thirteen  articles : — 1.  There  is  one  God, 
Creator  of  all  things,  aU-perfect,  all-sufficient. 
2.  That  he  is  an  uncompounded,  invisible 
essence.  3.  That  he  is  immaterial.  4.  Ab- 
solutely eternal.  5.  Alone  to  be  worshipped,, 
without  any  mediators  or  intercessors.  6. 
That  there  have  been,  and  may  be,  prophets. 

7.  That  Moses  was   the  greatest  prophet. 

8.  That  every  syllable  of  the  law  was  given 
to  Moses  by  inspiration ;  and  that  the  tra- 
ditionary expositions  of  the  precepts  were 
entirely  a  Divine  revelation  given  to  Moses. 

9.  That  the  law  is  immutable.  10.  That 
God  knows  and  governs  all  our  actions.. 
11.  That  he  rewards  the  observance,  and 
punishes  the  violation,  ■  of  his  laws.  12» 
That  the  Messiah  will  appear,  but  that  his 
coming  is  delayed.  13.  That  God  will  raise 
the  dead,  and  judge  all  mankind. 

There  have  from  early  times  been  three 
sects  of  Jews.  The  greatest  and  first  of  these 
is  that  of  the  Rabbanim,  who,  besides  the 
Scriptures,  receive  the  Talmud.  The  second 
is  the  Karaites,  who  receive  only  the  Scrip- 
tures ;  and  the  third  is  that  of  the  Cuthim, 
of  which  there  are  very  few,  who  admit 
only  the  Pentateuch,  or  books  of  Moses. — 
Broughton,  Biblio. :  Diet.  Christ.  Ant. : 
MUman's  History  of  Jews. 


JOB 

JOB.  One  of  the  books  in  the  sacred 
canon,  the  first  of  the  poetical  books  of  the 
Old  Testament,  and  probably  the  most 
ancient  work  that  exists  in  any  form.  There 
have  been  many  differences  of  opinion  upon 
almost  all  imaginable  questions  concerning 
this  book,  the  date,  the  scene,  the  author, 
whether  it  is  to  be  accounted  a  narrative  of 
real  events,  or  a  Divine  allegory,  being 
warmly  debated  by  different  critics.  (Smith's 
Diet,  of  Bible,  s.  v.)  That  Job  is  a  real 
person  seems  however  to  be  determined  by 
the  mention  of  him  with  Noah  and  Daniel 
(of  whose  proper  personal  existence  and 
history  there  can  be  no  doubt)  in  the  four- 
teenth chapter  of  Ezekiel.  The  author- 
ship is  quite  uncertain  (See  the  SpeaJcer's 
Commentary). 

JOHN,  ST.,  BAPTIST'S  DAY.  I.  This 
festival,  in  commemoration  of  St.  John  the 
Baptist's  birth,  is  obsei"ved  in  our  Calendar 
on  June  24 ;  in  that  of  the  Greek  Church 
on  January  7.  The  festival  is  mentioned 
frequently  by  St.  Augustine,  who  comments 
iipon  the  pecuUarity  of  observing  St.  John's 
birthday,  rather  than  his  martyrdom  {Som. 
287,  &c.). 

II.  The  minor  festival  observed  in  the 
Calendar  on  August  29  commemorates  the 
beheading  of  the  Baptist  (St.  Matt,  xiv.)  ; 
and  was  celebrated  in  the  Western  Church 
before  the  time  of  Gregory  the  Great,  a.d. 
590.  Many  curious  customs  were  connected 
with  this  day.  In  Ireland,  and  in  the  north 
of  England,  bonfires  were  lighted  on  the  eve. 
At  Magdalen  College,  Oxford,  an  open  air 
pulpit  was  used  on  this  day,  and  at  Win- 
chester College,  in  1407,  the  pulpit  was 
surrormded  with  boughs  and  green  candles, 
as  a  memorial  of  the  preacher  in  the  wilder- 
ness. In  Prance  wheels  were  rolled  in 
.allusion  to  the  sun's  declination,  bones  of 
animals  were  burned,  and  torches  carried  in 
allusion  to  St.  John  v.  36.  St.  John  is 
represented  clad  in  skins,  caiTyiug  a  pennon 
TOth  the  words  Ucce  Agnus  Dei. — Mabilloii, 
de  Lit.  Gall. ;  Walcott,  Sac.  Archseol.  p.  333  ; 
Blunt's  P.  B.  i.  [53]  ;  E.  Daniel,  P.  B.  [H.] 
JOHN,  ST.,  THE  EVANGELIST'S 
DAT ;  commemorated  on  Dec.  27.  St. 
John  and  St.  James  (the  Great)  were  the 
sons  of  Zebedee  of  Galilee,  and  Salome, 
who  is  supposed  to  have  been  the  sister  of 
the  Virgin  Mary.  St.  John  was  especially 
favoured  by  our  Lord.  Among  the  first 
called,  sharing  indeed  with  St.  Andrew  the 
title  of  TTpaiTOKKrjTos,  he  was  chosen  with 
his  brother  and  St.  Peter  to  accompany  the 
Lord  on  particular  occasions  (St.  Matt.  xxvi. 
37  ;  xvii.  1 ;  St.  Mark  v.  37 ;  ix.  2  ;  xiv.  33  ; 
St.  Luke  viii.  51 ;  ix.  20.  His  brother 
James  and  he  were  surnamed  by  our  Lord 
the  Sons  of  Thunder,  for  their  pecuhar  zeal 
and  fervency  for  His  honour. 


JOHN'S,  ST. 


417 


St.  John  exercised  his  ministry  in  Asia 
Minor,  and  having  excited  enemies  through 
preaching  the  doctrines  of  Christ,  was 
carried  prisoner  from  Ephesus  to  Rome,  in 
the  year  92.  Subsequently  to  this  he  was 
banished  to  the  isle  of  Patmos,  where  he 
wrote  his  Revelation.  He  was  afterwards 
recalled  from  his  exile  by  Nero  the  emperor, 
and  then  returned  to  Ephesus.  His  three 
Epistles  were  written  with  reference  to  some 
prevailing  heresies  of  the  times;  and  the 
scope  of  his  Gospel,  which  was  his  last  work, 
shows  that  the  apostle  had  in  view  the 
same  deniers  of  the  Divinity  of  the  Saviour. 
He  survived  till  the  reign  of  Trajan,  and 
died  at  the  age  of  nearly  100  years. 

JOHN'S,  ST.,  GENERAL  EPISTLES. 
Three  canonical  books  of  the  New  Testa- 
ment, being  letters  written  by  St.  John  the 
Evangelist  (See  the  last  article). 

The  First  Epislle  of  St.  John  has  always 
been  received  by  the  Church  as  genuine 
(Polycarp.  Ep.  ad  Philip,  c.  vii. ;  Irenajus, 
adv.  Hssr.  iii.  18 ;  Clemens  Alex.  Strom,  ii. ; 
St.  Cyprian,  Jip.  xxviii. ;  Origen,  S.  E.  vi. 
25,  &c.).  Though  there  is  neither  inscription 
nor  direction,  it  appears,  by  the  beginning  of 
chap,  ii.,  to  be  a  Catholic  or  General  Epistle, 
addressed  not  to  one,  but  many  Christians. 
It  is  probable  he  wrote  it  towards  the  end 
of  his  life,  because  he  mentions  the  opinion 
which  then  prevailed,  that  the  day  of  judg- 
ment was  at  hand,  and  Antichrist  ready  to 
appear.  He  insists  upon  the  advantages  of 
faith  in  Christ ;  he  exhorts  those  to  whom 
he  writes  not  to  suffer  themselves  to  be 
seduced  by  false  teachers ;  and  recommends 
to  them  good  works,  the  love  of  God  and 
our  neighbour,  purity,  and  other  Christian 
virtues.  This  Epistle,  for  matter  and  style, 
is  much  Hke  the  Gospel  written  by  the  same 
apostle. 

The  two  other  Epistles  which  carry  his 
name,  have  not  always  been  so  generally 
received.  On  the  contrary,  some  of  the 
ancients  were  of  opinion  that  they  were 
written  by  another  John,  called  the  Elder,  a 
disciple  of  the  apostle's,  mentioned  by 
Papias  (Euseb.  H.  E.  iiL  25).  However, 
Irenajus  quotes  the  second  under  the  name 
of  John,  the  disciple  of  our  Lord  (_Adv. 
Hxr.  i.  16).  In  truth,  the  spirit,  the  senti- 
ments, and  style  of  these  two  Epistles  are 
not  only  like,  but  often  the  same  as  the 
First  Epistle ;  which  plainly  bespeaks  one 
and  the  same  author. 

The  Second  Epistle  of  St.  John  is  directed 
to  the  elect  Lady  (^KvpLa) ;  by  which  some 
understand  a  person  of  that  name ;  others, 
only  some  lady  of  dignity  and  distinction ; 
and  others,  an  elect  or  chosen  Church,  me- 
taphorically styled  Lady.  Whoever  she  may 
have  been,  the  apostle  congratulates  her,  be- 
cause her  children  led  a  Christian  life.     He 

2  B 


418 


JOHN'S,  ST.,  GOSPEL 


cautions  her  likewise  to  beware  of  impos- 
tors, wlio  denied  that  Christ  was  come  in 
the  flesh. 

The  Third  Epistle  of  St.  John  is  directed 
to  Gaius,  or  Caius.  Whoever  he  may  have 
beeH  (for  this  is  controverted),  the  apostle 
declares  to  him  the  joy  he  conceived  when 
he  heard  of  his  piety  and  charity. 

It  is  probable  St.  John  wrote  his  Epistles, 
as  well  as  his  Gospel,  from  Ephesus,  after 
his  return  from  the  isle  of  Patmos. — Smith's 
Diet,  of  Bible. 

JOHN'S,  ST.,  GOSPEL.  A  canonical 
book  of  the  New  Testament,  being  a  re- 
cital of  the  life,  actions,  doctrine,  death, 
&c.,  of  our  Saviour  Jesus  Christ,  written 
by  St.  John  the  apostle  and  evangelist. 

It  has  always  been  considered  the  latest 
of  the  Gospels  (Euseb.  iii.  6,  and  vi.  14, 
quoting  Clemens  Alex.)  (See  the  pre- 
ceding article). 

According  to  tradition  St.  John  wrote  his 
Gospel  at  Ephesus,  after  his  return  from  the 
isle  of  Patmos,  at  the  desire  of  the  Chris- 
tians and  bishops  of  Asia  (Iren.  adv.  Hssr. 
ii.  22,  iii.  1 ;  Euseb.  H.  E.  v.  8,  &c. ;  Hieron. 
Prasfat.  in  Matt.).  St.  Jerome  says,  he  would 
not  undertake  it,  hut  on  condition  they  should 
appoint  a  public  fast,  to  implore  the  assistance 
of  God ;  and  that,  the  fast  being  ended,  St. 
John,  filled  with  the  Holy  Ghost,  broke  out 
into  these  words :  "  In  the  beginning  was 
the  Word,"  &c.  The  ancients  assign  two 
reasons  for  this  undertaking.  The  first  is, 
because,  in  the  other  three  Gospels,  there 
was  wanting  the  history  of  the  beginning  of 
Jesus  Christ's  preaching  tUl  the  imprison- 
ment of  John  the  Baptist ;  which  therefore 
he  apphed  himself  particularly  to  relate. 
The  second  reason  was,  in  order  to  confound 
the  errors  of  the  Cerinthians,  Ebionites,  and 
other  heretics,  who  denied  the  Divinity  of 
Jesus  Christ. — Iren.  iii.  12 ;  Hieron.  Cat. 
Ser.  Ecd.  9. 

Some  critics  have  thought  that  St. 
John's  Gospel  ended  at  the  20th  chapter 
with  these  words,  "  Many  other  signs  truly 
did  Jesus,"  &c.,  and  that  the  following 
chapter  was  added,  after  the  death  of  St. 
John,  by  the  Church  of  Ephesus  (^Lucke, 
Comment.  Johann  i.  pp.  197,  198.  See 
Wordsworth's  Ok.  Test.  i.  287). 

Clement  of  Alexandria  calls  this  Gospel 
"  the  spiritual  Gospel "  ;  and  St.  Jerome  says 
of  this  evangelist,  that  he  wrote  of  our 
Saviour's  Divinity  in  a  very  subUme  man- 
ner, and  with  a  happy  temerity.  Pagan  phi- 
losophers have  admired  the  sublimity  of 
St.  John's  Gospel.  Thus,  the  Platonist 
Amelius,  having  read  the  beginning  of  it, 
and  finding  it  conformable  to  the  doctrine  of 
Plato,  cried  out,  "  0  Jupiter !  this  Barbarian 
believes  with  Plato,  that  the  word  is  the 
beginning."     Guerike  {Einleitung,  p.  310, 


JOSHUA 

quoted  in  Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible)  gives  a 
list  of  the  chief  commentators  who  have 
accepted  or  rejected  the  authenticity  of  St. 
John's  Gosi^el.  The  question  is  exhaustively 
treated  by  Professor  Westcott,  Introduction 
to  St.  John  in  Speaker's  Commentary,  where 
he  successively  proves  that  the  author  must 
have  been  (i.)  a  Jew,  (ii.)  of  Palestine,  (iii.) 
an  eye-witness,  and  (iv.)  an  Apostle ;  and 
if  an  Apostle,  then  St.  John.  Dean  Alford 
arrives  at  the  same  conclusion  {Proleg.  c.  v.) ; 
see  also  Professor  Salmon,  Introdv/^tion  to 
New  Test.  [Murray]. 

JOINING  OP  HANDS,  THE.  This  is 
peculiar  to  the  EngUsh  rite  of  marriage ; 
but  was  derived  probably  from  Herman's 
"  Consultation."  "  The  joining  of  hands," 
says  Bishop  Barry,  "  is  from  time  imme- 
morial the  pledge  of  covenant,  and  is  here 
an  essential  part  of  the  marriage  ceremony." 
—P.  B.  161  (See  Matrimony).     [H.] 

JONAH.  The  most  ancient  of  the  pro- 
phetic books  of  the  Old  Testament,  which 
contains  also  a  jiart  of  the  history  of  the 
proiAet  whose  name  it  bears.  Jonah  is 
supposed  to  have  prophesied  to  the  teu 
tribes  towards  the  close  of  Jehu's  reign,  or 
in  the  beginning  of  Jehoahaz's  reign ;  but 
the  great  subject  of  the  book  which  bears 
his  name,  is  the  prophecy  which  he  was 
commissioned  to  utter  against  Nineveh, 
with  his  refusal  to  go,  his  punishment,  his 
second  mission,  and  the  repentance  of  the 
Ninevites.  The  concealment  of  Jonah  three 
days  in  the  belly  of  the  great  fish,  is  de- 
clared by  our  Blessed  Lord  himself  to  have 
been  a  predictive  sign  of  his  own  burial, 
and  of  his  resurrection  on  the  third  day 
(^Speaker's  Commentary). 

JOSHUA,  THE  BOOK  OF.  A  ca- 
nonical book  of  the  Old  Testament.  .  There 
have  been  different  opinions  about  the 
authorship  of  the  Book  of  Joshua;  the 
title  at  the  head  of  the  book  being  supposed 
by  some  not  to  denote  its  author,  but  the 
subject  matter  of  it,  being  the  history  of 
the  wars  and  transactions  which  happened 
under  the  administration  of  Joshua.  But 
"  all  that  part  of  the  Book  of  Joshua  which 
relates  his  personal  history  seems  to  be 
written  with  the  unconscious  vivid  power 
of  an  eyewitness "  (Diet.  Bib.  i.  1144). 
Joshua  (whose  name  at  first  was  Oshea)  was 
appointed  by  God  to  be  the  successor  of 
Moses,  and  to  lead  the  Israelites  in  safety, 
by  subduing  their  enemies,  into  the  promised 
land;  the  history  of  which  great  event  is 
the  subject  of  the  Book  of  Joshua;  which 
may  be  divided  into  three  parts.  The  first 
is  a  history  of  the  conquest  of  the  land  of 
Canaan.  The  second,  which  begins  at  the 
twelfth  chapter,  is  a  description  of  that 
country,  and  the  division  of  it  among  the 
tribes.     The   third,   comprised  in  the  two 


JUBE 

last  cliapters,  contains  the  ronevval  of  tlie 
covenant  he  caused  the  Israelites  to  make, 
and  the  death  of  their  victorious  leader  and 
governor.  The  whole  comprehend  a  term 
of  seventeen,  or,  according  to  others,  twenty- 
seven  years  {Speaker's  Commentary). 

II.  Joshua  has  always  been  considered  an 
especial  type  of  our  Lord  (See  Heb.  iv.  8). 
The  opinions  of  the  Christian  Fathers  on 
tills  subject  have  been  collected  by  Bishop 
Pearson  in  his  exposition  of  the  Creed 
(Art.  ii.  pp.  131  seq.,  Ed.  1859). 

JUBE.  A  Rood  loft,  or  galleiy  of  a 
chancel  screen,  so  called  in  France,  and 
formerly  sometimes  in  England,  from  the 
words,  "Jube  Domine  benedicere,"  pro- 
nounced from  it  when  a  dean  or  abbot  gave 
the  benediction.  The  Ambo  also,  from 
which  the  Epistle  and  Gospel  used  to  be 
read,  was  sometimes  so  called,  for  the  same 
reason. 

JUBILATE  DEO.  Ps.  c.  ("  0  be  joyful 
in  God  ").  One  of  the  psalms  appointed  to 
be  used  after  the  second  lesson  in  the 
morning  service.  It  was  formerly  sung  at 
lauds  and  came  hefore  the  lesson.  It  was 
inserted  in  its  present  place  in  the  Prayer 
Book  in  the  Second  Book  of  King  Edward 
VI.  The  intention  of  the  framers  of  the 
Prayer  Book  seems  to  have  been  that  this 
psabn  should  only  be  used  on  those  days 
when  the  "  Benedictus  "  came  in  the  lesson 
of  the  day,  or  for  the  Gospel  on  St.  John 
Baptist's  Day.  , 

JUBILEE  (Heb.  73^,  yohel:  signify- 
ing a  blast  of  a  trumpet).  I.  The  year  of 
Jubilee  in  the  Jewish  times  was  proclaimed 
with  trumpets,  and  was  a  year  of  universal 
hberty  and  freedom.  It  was  to  be  celebrated 
every  fifty  years  (Lev.  xxv.  9,  &c. ;  Josh.  vi. 
4, 13),  but  after  the  Babylonian  captivity  it 
was  not  observed  (See  Smith's  Diet,  of 
Bible). 

II.  A  Jubilee  was  instituted  in  the  year 
1300,  by  Boniface  VIII.,  which  was  to  be 
observed  every  hundredth  year,  and  was  to 
be  a  time  of  "  indulgence  " — that  is  to  say, 
all  censures,  greater  excommunications,  sus- 
pensions, interdicts,  or  vows  (except  those 
of  religion,  and  with  regard  to  pilgrimages 
to  Rome,  Jerusalem,  or  ComposteUa),  were 
to  be  remitted,  and  absolution  was  to  be 
granted  by  all  confessors,  with  the  approval 
of  the  ordinary.  Clement  VI.,  at  Avignon, 
reduced  the  period  of  the  Jubilee  to  every 
fiftieth  year.  In  1389  Urban  VI.  enjoLued 
that  it  should  be  held  every  thirty-third 
year.  Sixty  years'  later  Nicholas  V.  renewed 
the  former  observance  of  fifty  years ;  but 
Paul  II.  "reduced  the  teiTQ  to  twenty-five 
years.  Besides  this,  the  popes,  upon  their 
exaltation  to  the  see  of  Rome,  have  frequently 
celebrated  a  jubilee,  as  likewise  upon  other 
extraordinary    occasions.       The    ceremony 


JUDICIAL  COMMITTEE 


419 


observed  at  Rome,  for  the  Jubilee,  at  every 
twenty-five  years'  end,  which  they  call  the 
holy  year,  is  this:  The  pope  goes  to  St. 
Peter's  clmrch  to  open  the  holy  gate  (as 
they  call  it),  which  is  walled  up,  and  only 
opened  upon  this  occasion;  and  knocking 
three  times  at  the  said  gate,  with  a  golden 
hammer,  says  these  words,  Aperite  mihi 
portas  justitlts,  &c.,  "  Open  to  me  the  gates 
of  righteousness :  I  will  go  into  them  and  I 
will  praise  the  Lord "  (Psalm  cxviii.  19)  ; 
whereupon  the  masons  fall  to  work  to  break 
down  the  wall  that  stopped  the  gate ;  which 
done,  the  pope  kneels  down  before  it,  whilst 
the  penitentiaries  of  St.  Peter  sprinkle  him 
with  holy  water,  and  then  taking  up  the 
cross,  he  begins  to  sing  Te  Deum,  and 
enters  the  chm'ch,  followed  by  the  clergy. 
In  the  meanwhile,  three  cardinal  legates  are 
sent  to  open  the  other  three  holy  gates, 
with  the  same  ceremonies,  which  are  in  the 
churches  of  St.  John  of  Lateran,  of  St.  Paul, 
and  St.  Mary  Major ;  and  the  next  morning 
the  pope  gives  his  benediction  to  the  people 
in  the  Jubilee  form.  When  the  holy  year  is 
expired,  they  shut  up  the  holy  gates  again 
on  Christmas  eve  in  this  manner.  The 
pope,  after  he  has  blessed  the  stones  and 
mortar,  lays  the  first  stone,  and  leaves  there 
twelve  boxes  full  of  gold  and  silver  medals. 
— Milman,  Lat.  Christ,  v.  62,  332,  345,  420, 
431 ;  Walcott's  -Sac.  Arclixol.  334.     [H.] 

JUDE,  ST  (See  Simon  and  Jude,  SS.). 

JUDGES,  THE  BOOK  OF.  A  canonical 
book,  of  the  authenticity  of  which  there  is 
no  doubt  in  the  Church,  though  the  author 
is  unknown :  some  ascribing  it  to  Phinehas, 
others  to  Ezra  or  Hezekiah,  though  most  to 
Samuel  (See  Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible). 

JUDICIAL  COMMITTEE  OF  THE 
PRIVY  COUNCIL.  This  was  estabhshed 
by  3  &  4  W.  IV.  c.  41,  for  ecclesiastical  and 
admiralty  and  testamentary  appeals  which 
had  been  transferred,  by  the  Act  of  the 
previous  year,  to  the  Privy  Council  from 
the  delegates  who  used  to  be  appointed  pro 
hoc  vice  for  every  separate  appeal  under  the 
two  Acts  of  24  &  25  Henry  VIIL  (See 
Delegates).  Further  alterations  were  inade 
in  the  Judicial  Committee  by  the  Clergy 
Discipline  Act,  7  &  8  Vict.  c.  69,  which  made 
the  three  Privy  Council  bishops  members  of 
the  Committee  for  Appeals  under  that  Act 
but  not  others.  But  they  were  sometimes 
invited  as  assessors  in  other  cases,  e.g.  in  the 
Gorham  one.  In  1873  they  were  removed 
from  the  Committee  by  an  amendment 
slipped  into  the  Judicature  Act  (see  Life  of 
Wilberforce,  vol.  iii.).  By  the  Judicial  Com- 
mittee Act,  1871,  the  Queen  was  authorised 
to  appoint  four  persons  who  had  been  judges 
(if  only  for  a  day)  to  be  members  of  the 
Judicial  Committee  with  salaries  of  £5000  a 
year,  but  practically  to  fill  up  no  vacancies 

2  E  2 


420 


JtJEE  DIVINO 


among  tliem.  By  the  Appellate  Jurisdiction 
Act,  1876,  -which  established  three  law  lords 
with  life  peerages,  they  are  also  to  be  mem- 
bers of  the  Judicial  Committee,  and  in  all 
ecclesiastical  appeals  the  bishops  are  required 
to  sit  as  assessors  under  rules  which  were  to 
be  made,  and  which  are  in  fact  that  they  are 
to  be  summoned  in  rotation,  five  at  once,  of 
whom  three  must  sit — even  on  mere  legal 
technicalities.  Another  Act  was  passed  in 
1881  (44  &  45  Vict.  c.  3,  and  the  result  of 
ail  the  Acts  is  this  for  the  present:  The 
Judicial  Committee  consists  of  all  judges 
and  ex-judges  of  the  Supreme  Court,  in- 
cluding of  course  the  Lord  Chancellor  and 
the  Dean  of  Arches,  if  they  are  Privy 
CouncUlors,  and  also  three  law  lords  and  the 
survivors  of  the  four  judges  appointed  rmder 
the  1871  Act,  and  also  three  others  who 
may  be  appointed  from  time  to  time  with- 
out salary  under  the  first  Judicial  Committee 
Act  of  1833,  who  may  be  anybody,  and  one 
of  whom  was  never  even  a  practising  barris- 
ter ;  but  another  did  more  than  any  member 
who  ever  sat  to  raise  the  reputation  of  the 
Court,  viz.,  Mr.  Pemberton  Leigh,  afterwards 
Lord  Kingsdown,  who  refused  the  Great 
Seal.     [&•] 

"  JURE  DIVINO."  By  Divine  right ; 
an  expression  frequently  occurring  in  con- 
troversial writings,  especially  in  relation  to 
the  ministry  of  the  Church. 

It  is  evident,  and  generally  confessed, 
that  the  right  to  minister  in  holy  things  is 
not  in  every  man's  power.  If  it  were  so, 
the  very  idea  of  the  ministry,  as  a  dis- 
tinct class  of  men,  empowered  to  act  "  in 
Christ's  stead,"  would  be  broken  up,  and 
the  Church  would  lose  its  character  as  a 
society ;  for  that  implies  the  existence  of 
officers  and  of  subordination.  It  is  also 
confessed  that  in  the  Christian  Church  men 
are  not  iorn  to  the  ministry,  as  they  were 
imder  the  Jewish  dispensation.  Whence, 
then,  comes  that  authority  with  which  the 
ambassador  of  Christ  is  invested  ?  Is  it 
human  ?  Can  any  body  of  men  confer  the 
power  to  rule  and  minister  in  a  society, 
the  full  control  of  which  is  in  the  hands 
of  the  eternal  God?  Most  evidently  not. 
Human  power,  or  a  commission  derived 
from  human  resources,  is  as  void  and  in- 
adequate in  qualifying  for  the  functions  of 
the  ministry,  as  it  would  be  in  the  attempt 
to  create  a  world,  or  to  found  a  new  rank 
in  the  hierarchy  of  heaven.  We  are  driven 
then,  at  once,  to  the  Divine  institution  as 
the  foundation  of  all  legitimate  power  in 
the  Church. 

The  Head  of  the  Church  established  a 
ministry,  with  the  right  and  abiUty  to  exe- 
cute all  its  ai^pointed  functions.  It  was 
not  intellectual  eminence,  or  high  station, 
or  influence,  wealth,  courage,  or  any  other 


JURISDICTION 

human  attribute,  which  brought  into  being; 
"  the  glorious  company  of  the  apostles ; " 
but  it  was  the  sovereign  power  alone  of 
Him  "  in  whom  dwelt  all  the  fulness  of  the 
Godhead  bodily."  And  was  this  power 
to  be  recalled  on  the  demise  of  those  wha 
were  every  day  doomed  to  stripes,  impri- 
sonments, perils,  and  death  in  a  thousand 
shapes  ?  No ;  for  either  the  Church  for 
the  future  must  fail,  the  sacraments  be 
obliterated,  the  "  watching  for  souls "  be 
abolished,  or  the  contuiuation  of  the  sacred 
ministry  must  be  demanded  with  all  its 
original  spiritual  functions.  To  the  apos- 
tles, therefore,  was  given  (jure  divino),  and 
to  them  alone,  the  ability  to  perpetuate  or 
transmit  the  gift  which  the  Redeemer  had 
bestowed.  Prom  them  the  prerogatives  of 
episcopacy  (or  apostolate)  were  communi- 
cated to  younger  men,  including  the  trans- 
missive  or  ordaining  faculty.  Under  these, 
the  elders  and  deacons  were  put  in  trust 
with  a  share  of  the  original  grant  of  minis- 
terial power, — a  power  they  were  them- 
selves incapable  of  delegating ;  and  by  au 
unbroken  succession,  in  the  line  of  bishops, 
the  Divine  commission  has  reached  these 
latter  days  of  the  Church. 

If  then,  as  we  have  shown.  Divine  right 
is  the  only  foundation  on  which  the  minis- 
try can  stand,  there  is  no  alternative  left 
to  any  one  claiming  ofiE.ce  in  the  Church 
of  God,  but  to  vindicate  the  legality  of  his- 
mission  by  miracle,  or  some  other  tangible 
Divine  verification,  which  no  man  can  dis- 
pute; or  else  to  bring  forth  such  creden- 
tials as  Timothy,  Titus,  and  the  ministers 
ordained  by  them  had  to  show,  viz.  the 
simple  evidence  of  the  fact  that  the  apostles, 
or  their  successors,  had  imparted  to  them, 
the  authority  they  claim  to  possess.  This 
every  bishop,  priest,  and  deacon,  in  the 
Catholic  Church,  is  prepared  to  do. 

JURISDICTION.  The  power  and  au- 
thority vested  in  a  bishop,  by  virtue  of  the 
apostolical  commission,  of  governing  and 
administering  the  laws  of  the  Church 
within  the  bounds  of  his  diocese.  The 
same  term  is  used  to  express  the  bounds 
withiu  which  a  bishop  exercises  his  power, 
i.e.  his  diocese. 

In  the  Anglo-Saxon  times,  before  the  Nor- 
man Conquest,  there  was  no  distinction  of 
jurisdiction ;  but  all  matters,  as  well  spiri- 
tual as  temporal,  were  determined  in  the 
county  court,  called  the  Sheriff's  Tourn, 
where  the  bishop  and  earl  (or  in  his  ab- 
sence the  sheriti')  sat  together;  or  else  in 
the  hundred  court,  which  was  held  in  like 
manner  before  the  lord  of  the  hrmdred  and 
ecclesiastical  judge. 

For  the  ecclesiastical  officers  took  their 
limits  of  jurisdiction  from  a  like  extent  of 
the  civil  powers.    Most  of  the  early  Bnghsh 


JUKISDICTION 

bislioprlcs  were  conterminous  ■with,  the 
■distinct  kingdoms.  The  archdeaconries, 
when  first  settled  into  local  districts  [which 
however  does  not  seem  to  have  been  ef- 
fected before  the  Norman  Conquest],  were 
commonly  fitted  to  the  respective  counties. 
And  rural  deaneries  were  correspondent  to 
the  political  tithings.  Their  spiritual  courts 
were  held,  with  a  like  reference  to  the  ad- 
ministration of  civO.  justice.  The  synods 
of  each  province  and  diocese  were  held  at 
the  discretion  of  the  metropolitan  and  the 
bishop,  as  great  councils  at  the  pleasure  of 
the  prince.  The  visitations  were  first  united 
to  the  civil  inquisitions  in  each  county ; 
and  afterwards,  when  the  courts  of  the  earl 
and  bishop  were  separated,  yet  still  the 
visitations  were  held  hke  the  sheriff's 
tourns,  twice  a  year,  and  like  them  too 
after  Easter  and  Michaelmas,  and  still, 
with  nearer  hkeness,  the  greater  of  them 
was  at  Easter.  The  rural  chapters  were 
also  held,  like  the  inferior  courts  of  the 
hundred,  every  three  weeks ;  then,  and  like 
them  too,  they  were  changed  into  monthly, 
and  at  last,  into  quarterly  meetings  ;  and  a 
prime  visitation  was  held  commonly,  like 
the  prime  folcmote  or  sheriff's  tourn,  on  the 
■calends  of  May. 

And  accordingly  Sir  Henry  Spelman 
•observes,  that  the  bishop  and  the  earl  sat 
together  in  one  court,  and  heard  jointly 
the  causes  of  chm'ch  and  commonwealth ; 
as  they  yet  do  in  parliament.  And  as  the 
bishop  had  twice  in  the  year  two  general 
synods,  wherein  all  the  clergy  of  his  dio- 
■cese  of  all  sorts  were  bound  to  resort  for 
matters  concerning  the  Church;  so  also 
there  was  twice  in  the  year  a  general  as- 
sembly of  all  the  shire  for  matters  con- 
■ceming  the  commonwealth,  wherein,  with- 
out exception,  all  kinds  of  estates  were 
required  to  be  present,  dukes,  earls,  barons, 
and  so  downward  of  the  laity ;  and  especi- 
ally the  bishop  of  that  diocese  among  the 
■clergy.  For  in  those  days  the  temporal 
lords  sat  in  synods  with  the  bishops, 
and  the  bishops  in  like  manner  in  the 
•courts  of  the  temporality,  and  were  there- 
in not  only  necessary,  but  the  principal 
judges  themselves.  Thus  by  the  laws 
of  King  Canute,  "the  shyre-gemot  (for  so 
the  Saxons  called  this  assembly  of  the 
whole  shire)  shall  be  kept  twice  a  year, 
and  oftener  if  need  require,  wherein  the 
bishop  and  the  alderman  of  the  shire  shall 
be  present,  the  one  to  teach  the  laws  of 
■God,  the  other  the  laws  of  the  land." 
And  among  the  laws  of  King  Henry  I.,  it 
is  ordained,  "first,  let  the  laws  of  true 
•Christianity  (which  we  call  the  ecclesiasti- 
cal) be  fully  executed  with  due  satisfaction ; 
then  let  the  pleas  concerning  the  king  be 
•dealt    vrith;    and,    lastly,    those    between 


JUEISDIOTION 


421 


party  and  party:  and  whomsoever  the 
Church  synod  shall  find  at  variance,  let 
them  either  make  accord  between  them  in 
love,  or  sequester  them  by  their  sentence 
of  excommunication."  And  the  bishop 
first  gave  a  solemn  charge  to  the  people 
touching  ecclesiastical  matters,  opening 
unto  them  the  rights  and  reverence  of  the 
Church,  and  their  duty  therein  towards 
God  and  the  king,  according  to  the  word 
of  God :  then  the  alderman  in  like  manner 
related  unto  them  the  laws  of  the  land,  and 
their  duty  towards  God,  the  king,  and  com- 
monwealth, according  to  the  rule  and  tenm-e 
thereof. 

The  separation  of  the  ecclesiastical  from 
the  temporal  courts  was  made  by  William 
the  Conqueror :  for  upon  the  conquest  made 
by  the  Normans,  the  pope  took  the  oppor- 
tunity to  usurp  upon  the  liberties  of  the 
crown  of  England ;  for  the  Conqueror  came 
in  with  the  pope's  banner,  and  under  it  won 
the  battle.  Whereupon  the  pope  sent  two 
legates  into  England,  with  whom  the  Con- 
queror called  a  synod,  deposed  Stigand, 
archbishop  of  Canterbury,  because  he  had 
not  purchased  his  pall  from  Rome,  and  dis- 
placed many  bishops  and  abbots  to  make 
room  for  his  Normans.  This  admission  of 
the  pope's  legates  first  led  the  way  to  his 
usurped  jurisdiction  in  England;  yet  no 
decrees  passed  or  were  put  in  execution, 
touching  matters  ecclesiastical,  without  the 
royal  assent;  nor  would  the  king  submit 
himself  in  point  of  fealty  to  the  pope,  as 
appears  by  his  epistle  to  Gregory  VII. 
Yet  in  his  next  successor's  time,  namely, 
in  the  time  of  King  WOUam  Eufus,  the 
pope,  by  Anselm,  archbishop  of  Canterbury, 
attempted  to  draw  appeals  to  Rome,  but 
did  not  prevail.  Upon  this  occasion  it  was, 
that  the  king  said  to  Anselm,  that  none 
of  his  bishops  ought  to  be  subject  to  the 
pope,  but  the  pope  himself  ought  to  be 
subject  to  the  emperor ;  and  that  the  king 
of  England  had  the  same  absolute  liberty  in 
his  dominions,  as  the  emperor  had  in  the 
empire.  Yet  in  the  time  of  the  next  king, 
King  Henry  I.,  the  pope  usurped  the  pa- 
tronage and  donation  of  bishoprics,  and  of 
all  other  benefices  ecclesiastical.  At  this 
time  Anselm  told  the  king  that  the  in- 
vestiture of  bishops  was  not  his  right, 
because  Pope  Urban  II.  had  lately  made 
a  decree,  that  no  recipient  of  an  ecclesiastical 
benefice  should  take  any  oath  of  fealty  ior 
the  same  to  a  layman.  And  after  this,  at 
a  synod  held  at  London,  in  the  year  1107, 
a  decree  was  made  to  which  the  kmg 
assented,  that  from  thenceforth  no  person 
should  be  invested  by  any  lay  hand  in  a 
bishopric  by  the  giving  of  a  ring  and  pastoral 
staff.  Upon  which  the  pope  granted  that  the 
archbishop  of  Canterbury  for  the  time  being 


422 


JUSTIFICATION 


should  be  for  ever  legatus  natus :  and  An- 
selm  for  the  honour   of  his  see  obtained, 
that  the  archbishop  of  Canterbury  should 
in  all  general  councils  sit  at  the  pope's  foot, 
as  alterius  orbis  papa,  or  pope  of  this  part 
of  the  world.     Yet  after  Anselm's  death, 
this  same  lung  gave  the  archbishopric  of 
Canterbury  to  Ralph,  bishop  of   London, 
and  invested  him  with  the  ring  and  pas- 
toral staff;  and  this  because  the  succeeding 
popes  had  broken  Pope  Urban's  promise, 
touching  the  not  sending   of  legates  into 
England  unless  the  king  should  require  it. 
And  in  the  time  of  the  next  king,  King 
Stephen,  the  pope  gained  appeals  to   the 
court  of  Eome ;  for  in  a  synod  at  London, 
convened  by  Henry,  bishop  of  Winchester, 
the  pope's  legate,  it  was  decreed  that  ap- 
peals should  be  made  from  provincial  coun- 
cils to  the  pope  :'  before  which  time  appeals 
to  Eome  were  not  in  use.     Thus  did  the 
ix)pe  usurp  three  main  points  of  jurisdiction, 
upon  three  several  kings  after  the  Conquest 
(for  of  King  WUliam  Kufus  he  could  gain 
nothing),   viz.   upon    the    Conqueror,    the 
sending  of  the  legates  or  commissioners  to 
hear  and  determine    ecclesiastical  causes ; 
upon  Henry  I.,  the  donation  and  investiture 
of  bishoprics  and  other  benefices ;  and  upon 
King  Stephen,  the  appeals  to  the  court  of 
Eome.     And  in  the  time  of  King  Henry 
II.,  the  pope  claimed  exemption  for  clerks 
from  the  secular  power.    And  finally,  in  the 
time  of  King  John,  he  took  the  crown  from 
off  the  king's  head,  and  compelled  him  to  ac- 
cept his  kingdom  from  the  pope's  donation. 
Nevertheless  all  this  was  not  obtained  with- 
out violent  struggle  and  opposition :   and 
this  caused  the  statutes  of  provisors  to  be 
made,  in  the  reigns  of  King  Edward  I.  and 
King  Eichard  II.     The    limits  of   eoole- 
i  siastical  jurisdiction  were  finally  settled  by 
•the  statute  of  24  Henry  VIII.  c.  12.     Juris- 
;  diction  is  also  applied  to  the  power  vested 
;ih  certain  dignitaries,  as  dean,  chancellor, 
,  &c.,  in  some  cathedrals ;  and  in  many,  when 
■each: individual  prebendary  had  a  peculiar 
.jurisdiction  (See  Eeport  of  the  Commission 
■  on  (EQclesiastical  Courts,   1883,  but  more 
'.especially,  the; '  Historical    Appendix    by 
;Bishop  Stilbb's;  also  Supremacy). 
-.j.-JcUpi-EIQATION     (See     Faith     and 
,'Sqhptific.ation).     Justification,  in  the  lan- 
iguage\6f;  Scripture,  signifies  our  being  ac- 
coimted  just  or  righteous  in  the  sight  of 
God;;    ■.  ,  ,, 

A  clear  .understanding  of  the  difference 
between  .the  Church  of  England  and  the 
Church  of  Eome  \ipon  this  subject  is  most 
important,  since  the  difference  Isetween  the 
two  Churches  on  this  point  causes  an  essen- 
tial and  vital  difference  through  the  whole 
system  of  their  theology.  The  definition 
of  the  Church  of  England  is  set  forth  in 


JUSTIFICATION 

her  Articles  and  Homilies :  and  it  is  there 
propounded  in  a  manner  so  perspicuous,  as 
to  preclude,  it  might  well  be  thought,  all 
possibility  of  misapprehension. 

As  contained  in  the  eleventh  and  twelfth 
and  thirteenth  Articles,  the  definition  rims 
in  terms  following : 

"  We  are  accounted  righteous  before  God, 
only  for  the  merit  of  our  Lord  and  Sa'sdour 
Jesus  Christ  by  faith ;  and  not  for  our  o-wn 
works  or  deservings.  Wherefore,  that  we  are 
justified  by  faith  only  is  a  most  wholesome 
doctrine,  and  very  full  of  comfort :  as  more 
largely  is  expressed  in  the  Homily  of  Justifi- 
cation. 

"  Albeit  that  good  works,  which  are  the 
fruits  of  faith  and  follow  after  justification, 
cannot  put  away  our  sins,  and  endure  the 
severity  of  God's  judgment;  yet  are  they 
pleasing  and  acceptable  to  God  in  Christ, 
and  do  spring  out  necessarily  of  a  true  and 
lively  faith;  insomuch  that  by  them  a 
lively  faith  may  be  as  evidently  known  as 
a  tree  is  discerned  by  the  fruit. 

"  Works  done  before  the  grace  of  Christ, 
and  the  inspiration  of  His  Spirit,  are  not 
pleasant  to  God,  forasmuch  as  they  spring 
not  of  faith  in  Jesus  Christ,  neither  do  they 
make  men  meet  to  receive  grace,  or  (as  the 
school-authors  say)  deserve  grace  of  con- 
gruity :  yea  rather,  for  that  they  are  not 
done  as  God  hath  willed  and  commanded 
them  tb  be  done,  we  doubt  not  but  they 
have  the  natxire  of  sin." 

The  homily  referred  to  in  the  eleventh 
Article,  under  the  title  of  Tlie  Homily  cf 
Justification,  is  styled,  in  the  first  Book  of 
Homilies  itself,  "  A  sermon  of  the  salvation 
of  mankind,  by  only  Christ  our  Saviour, 
from  sin  and  death  everlasting  : "  and  this 
homily  is  described  as  more  largely  ex- 
pressing the  doctrine  of  justification  than 
the  necessary  brevity  of  an  article  ad- 
mitted. 

The  doctrine  of  the  Church  of  Eome  must 
be  taken  from  the  Council  of  Trent.'  The 
exposition  of  the  Tridentine  Fathers,  as- 
sembled in  their  sixth  session,  runs  through 
sixteen  chapters ;  and  so  extreme  is  its  ver- 
boseness,  and  so  perplexing  is  its  incessant 
alternation,  that  we  might  be  somewhat 
puzzled  to  form  a  distinct  idea  of  their 
views  in  respect  to  justification.  If  the  last 
of  those  chapters  had  not  given  us,  in  the 
shape  of  an  article  or  summary,  the  result 
of  their  prohs  theologising. 

Omitting,  then,  the  discussion  upon  which 
their  definition  is  built,  we  will  proceed 
immediately  to  the  definition  itself. 

"  Since  Jesus  Christ,  as  the  head  into  the 
members  and  as  the  vine  into  the  branches, 
perpetually  causes  his  virtue  to  flow  into  the 
justified ;  which  virtue  always  precedes  and 
accompanies  and  follows  their  good  works. 


JUSTIFICATION 

and  without  which  they  would  iu  nowise  be 
grateful  to  God  and  meritorious ;  we  must 
believe,  that  nothing  more  is  wanting  to  the 
justified  themselves,  which  need  prevent  us 
from  thinking,  both  that  they  can  satisfy 
the  Divine  law  according  to  the  state  of 
this  life,  by  those  works  which  are  per- 
formed in  God;  and  that,  in  their  owa 
time,  provided  they  depart  iu  grace,  they 
may  truly  merit  the  attainment  of  eternal 
life. 

"  Thus,  neither  our  own  proper  righteous- 
ness is  so  determined  to  be  our  own,  as  if  it 
were  from  ourselves ;  nor  is  the  righteous- 
ness of  God  either  unknown  or  rejected. 
For  that  which  is  called  our  righteousness, 
because,  through  it  being  inherent  in  us,  we 
are  justified ;  that  same  is  the  righteousness 
of  God,  because  it  is  infused  into  us  by  God 
through  the  merit  of  Christ. 

"Far,  however,  be  it  from  a  Christian 
man,  that  he  should  either  trust  or  glory  in 
himself  and  not  in  the  Lord ;  whose  good- 
ness to  all  men  is  so  great,  that,  what  are 
truly  his  gifts,  he  willeth  to  be  estimated  as 
their  merits." 

This  article  or  summary  removes  all 
possibility  of  misapprehension.  Through 
it,  the  Church  of  Bome  determines  that  we 
are  justified,  not  by  any  imputation  to  us  of 
righteousness,  or  by  any  imputation  to  us  of 
faith  in  the  place  of  righteousness  (though 
each  of  these  imputations  is  insisted  upon 
by  St.  Paul),  but  by  our  own  inherent 
righteousness. 

On  this,  the  Eoman  system.  Hooker 
remarks  :  "  When  they  are  required  to  show, 
whatthe  righteousness  is  whereby  a  Christian 
man  is  justified,  they  answer,  that  it  is  a 
Divine  spiritual  quality  :  which  quality, 
received  into  the  soul,  doth  first  make  it  to 
be  one  of  them  who  are  born  of  God ;  and, 
secondly,  endue  it  with  power  to  bring  forth 
such  works  as  they  do  that  are  born  of  him  : 
even  as  the  soul  of  man,  being  joined  to  his 
body,  doth  first  make  him  to  be  of  the  num- 
ber of  reasonable  creatures ;  and,  secondly, 
enable  him  to  perform  the  natural  functions 
which  are  proper  to  his  kind :  that  it  maketh 
the  soul  amiable  and  gracious  in  the  sight 
of  God,  in  regard  whereof  it  is  termed 
Grace ;  that  it  purgeth,  purifieth,  and 
washeth  out,  all  the  stains  and  pollutions 
of  sins ;  that,  by  it,  through  the  merit  of 
Christ,  we  are  delivered,  as  from  sin,  so  from 
eternal  death  and  condemnation,  the  reward 
of  sin.  This  grace  they  will  have  to  be 
applied  by  infusion ;  to  the  end  that,  as  the 
bodj'  is  warm  by  the  heat  which  is  in  the 
body,  so  the  soul  might  be  made  righteous 
by  inherent  grace  :  which  grace  they  make 
capable  of  increase;  as  the  body  inay  be 
more  and  more  warm,  so  the  soul  more  and 
more  justified  according  as  grace  should  be 


JUSTIFICATION 


423 


augmented;  the  augmentation  whereof  is 
merited  by  good  works,  as  good  works  are 
made  meritorious  by  it.  Wherefore,  the 
first  receipt  of  grace,  in  their  divinity,  is 
the  first  justification :  the  increase  thereof, 
the  second  justification.  As  grace  may  be 
increased  by  the  merit  of  good  works,  so  it 
may  be  diminished  by  the  demerit  of  sins 
venial ;  it  may  be  lost  by  mortal  sin.  Inas- 
much, therefore,  as  it  is  needful,  in  the  one 
case  to  repair,  in  the  other  to  recover,  the 
loss  which  is  made,  the  infusion  of  grace 
hath  her  sundry  after-meals ;  for  the  which 
cause  they  make  many  ways  to  apply  the 
infusion  of  grace.  It  is  applied  to  infants 
through  baptism,  without  either  faith  or 
works ;  and,  in  them,  really  it  taketh  away 
original  sin,  and  the  punishment  due  unto 
it :  it  is  applied  to  infidels  and  wicked  men 
in  the  first  justification,  through  baptism, 
without  works,  yet  not  without  faith :  and 
it  taketh  away  sins  both  actual  and  original 
together,  with  all  whatsoever  punishment, 
eternal  or  temporal,  thereby  deserved.  Unto 
such  as  have  attained  the  first  justification, 
that  is  to  say,  the  first  receipt  of  grace,  it  is 
applied  further  by  good  works  to  the  in- 
crease of  former  grace  :  which  is  the  second 
justification.  If  they  work  more  and  more, 
grace  doth  more  increase :  and  they  are  more 
and  more  justified.  To  such  as  diminish  it 
by  venial  sins,  it  is  applied  by  holy  water, 
Ave  Marias,  crossings,  papal  salutations,  and 
such  like :  which  serve  for  reparations  of 
grace  decayed.  To  such  as  have  lost  it 
through  mortal  sin,  it  is  applied  by  the 
sacrament  (as  they  term  it)  of  penance: 
which  sacrament  hath  force  to  confer  grace 
anew ;  yet  in  such  sort,  that,  being  conferred; 
it  hath  not  altogether  so  much  power  as  at 
the  first.  For  it  only  cleanseth  out  the 
stain  or  guilt  or  sin  committed ;  and 
changeth  the  punishment  eternal  into  a 
temporal  satisfactory  punishment — here,  if 
time  do  serve,  if  not,  hereafter,  to  be  en- 
dured; except  it  be  lightened  by  masses, 
works  of  charity,  pilgrimages,  fasts,  and  such 
like  ;  or  else  shortened  by  pardon  for  term,  or 
by  plenary  pardon  quite  removed  and  taken 
away.  This  is  the  mystery  of  the  man  of 
sin.  This  maze  the  Church  of  Home  doth 
cause  her  followers  to  tread,  when  they  ask 
her  the  way  to  justification.  Whether  they 
speak  of  the  first  or  second  justification, 
they  make  '  the  essence  of  a  Divine  quality 
inherent,'  they  make  it '  righteousness  which 
is  in  us.'  If  it  be  in  us,  then  it  is  ours :  as 
our  souls  are  ours,  though  we  have  them 
from  God,  and  can  hold  them  no  longer  than 
pleaseth  him  ;  for,  if  he  withdraw  the  breath 
of  our  nostrils,  we  fall  to  dust.  But  the 
righteousness,  wherein  we  must  be  found,  if 
we  will  be  justified,  is  '  not  our  own.' 
Therefore  we  cannot  be  justified  by  any 


124 


JUSTIFICATION 


inherent  quality.  The  Church  of  Rome,  in 
teaching  justification  hy  inherent  grace, 
doth  pervert  the  truth  of  Christ :  and,  by 
the  hands  of  the  apostles,  we  have  received 
otiierwise  than  she  teacheth..  Now,  con- 
cerning the  righteousness  of  sanotifioation, 
we  deny  it  not  to  be  inherent :  we  grant, 
that,  unless  we  work,  we  have  it  not :  only 
we  distinguish  it,  as  a  thing  different  in 
nature  from  the  righteousness  of  justification. 
By  the  one,  we  are  interested  in  the  rigid  of 
inheriting :  by  the  other,  we  are  brought  to 
the  actual  possession  of  eternal  bliss.  And 
so  the  end  of  both  is  '  everlasting  life ' " 
(/Serm.  il.  5,  6). 

The  difference  between  the  two  systems 
may  be  pointed  out  in.  a  few  words.  The 
Eoman  Church  teaches  that  a  man  is  jus- 
tified by  an  inherent  righteousness,  which 
though  originally  a  gift  of  God,  as  are  his  soul 
and  his  bodily  members,  is  nevertheless, 
like  his  soul,  his  own. 

The  Anghcan  Church,  on  the  contrary, 
in  common  with  all  the  other  Churches  of 
the  Eeformation,  teaches :  "  that  man  is 
justified  by  an  extrinsic  righteousness, 
which  is  not  his  own,  but  the  righteous- 
ness of  Christ ;  the  faith  which  instru- 
mentally  lays  hold  of  it  and  appropriates 
it,  and  which  itself  is  the  gift  of  God,,  be- 
ing forensicaUy  imputed  to  him  of  God, 
instead  of  a  righteousness  which  he  him- 
self possesses  not ;  so  that  he  is  justified 
through  faith,  though  not  on  account  of 
faith ;  the  sole  particular,  on  account  of 
which  he  is  justified,  being  the  merit  and 
perfect  righteousness  of  our  Lord  and  only 
Saviour  Jesus  Christ." 

Whichever  scheme  of  doctrine  may  be 
preferred  as  most  agreeable  to  Scripture 
and  to  antiquity,  it  is  clear,  that  the  two 
statements  here  given  are  at  least  incapable 
of  misapprehension.  Eight  or  wrong,  the 
two  schemes  stand  flatly  and  diametrically 
opposed  to  each  other.  The  Eoman  Church 
asserts :  the  Anglican  Church  denies. 
Conversely,  the  Eoman  Church  denies :  the 
Anglican  Church  asserts.  The  Eoman 
Church  asserts  the  doctrine  of  justification 
by  an  infused  and  personal  inherent 
righteousness  :  the  Anglican  Church  strenu- 
ously denies  that  doctrine;  admitting, 
indeed,  that  the  inherent  righteousness  of 
sanotifioation  is  always  consequentially 
present  with  the  really  justified;  but  re- 
fusing to  it  any,  even  the  least,  share  in 
"  the  procurement  of  justification."  The 
Eoman  Church  denies,  that  the  ungodly  is 
justified  through  faith  alone,  nothing  else 
being  required  to  obtain  the  grace  of  justi- 
fication: the  Anglican  Church  asserts, 
that  the  ungodly  is  justified  through  faith 
alone  without  works,  nothing  save  faith 
being  required  to  obtain  the  grace  of  jus- 


JUSTITIOATION 

tification,  inasmuch  as  the  office  of  works 
is  not  the  procurement  of  our  justification, 
and  inasmuch  as  it  is  a  contradictory  hys- 
teron-proteron  to  say  that  works  which 
"follow  after"  justification,  and  are  its 
"effect,"  can  yet  "procure"  it  arnd  be  its 
"  cause." 

It  has  been  customary  to  speak  of  the 
doctrine  of  forensic  justification  as  if  it 
were  a  Calviuistic  doctrine.  That  Calvin 
held  it  is  not  to  be  denied,  but  all  history 
bears  witness  that  it  is  not  a  peculiarity  of 
the  Calvinistic  system. 

Calvin  was  born  in  1509,  and  he  was  yet 
a  schoolboy,  or  a  plurahst  in  the  Eomish 
Church  (as  he  became  in  his  twelfth  year), 
when  Luther  was  using  this  doctrine,  as 
the  doctrine  by  which  to  lay  low  the  whole 
fabric  of  Eomish  superstition. 

Again,  it  was  the  doctrine  of  our  English 
refoimers,  as  most  clearly  stated  in  our 
Articles  and  Homilies;  and  Archbishop 
Laurence  has  triumphantly  established  the 
historical  fact,  that  our  reformers  were  not 
Calvinists. 

If  we  wish  for  a  clear  statement  of  the 
doctrine  of  forensic  justification,  we  may 
indeed  refer  to  Bishop  Andrewes ;  and  the 
theology  of  Andrewes  had  certainly  no 
affinity  to  that  of  Calvin.  Let  the  reader 
peruse  with  attention  the  foUowing  passage 
from  his  sermon  on  justification. 

"  In  the  Scripture,  then,  there  is  a  double 
righteousness  set  down,  both  in  the  Old 
and  in  the  New  Testament. 

"  In  the  Old,  and  in  the  very  first  place 
that  righteousness  is  named  in  the  Bible: 
'Abraham  believed,  and  it  was  accounted 
unto  him  for  righteousness.'  A  righteous- 
ness accounted.  And  again,  in  the  very 
next  line,  it  is  mentioned,  '  Abraham  will 
teach  his  house  to  do  righteousness.'  A 
righteousness  done.  In  the  New  likewise. 
The  former,  in  one  chapter,  even  the  fourth 
to  the  Eomans,  no  fewer  than  eleven  times, 
Reputatum  est  illi  ad  justitiam.  A  re- 
puted righteousness.  The  latter  in  St. 
John:  'My  beloved,  let  no  man  deceive 
you,  he  that  doeth  righteousness  is 
righteous.'  A  righteousness  done.  Which 
is  nothing  else  but  our  just  dealing,  upright 
carriage,  honest  conversation.  Of  these, 
the  latter  the  philosophers  themselves  con- 
ceived and  acknowledged;  the  other  is 
proper  to  Christians  only,  and  altogether 
unknown  in  jihUosophy.  The  one  is  a 
quality  of  the  party;  the  other,  an  act  of 
the  judge  declaring  or  pronouncing  righteous. 
The  one  ours  by  influence  or  infusion,  the 
other  by  account  or  imputation.  That 
both  these  there  are,  there  is  no  question. 
The  question  is,  whether  of  these  the 
prophet  here  principally  meaneth  in  this 
Name  ?     This   shall  we  best  inform  our- 


JUSTIFICATION 

selves  of  by  looking  back  to  the  verse 
before,  and  witliout  so  looldng'  back  we 
shall  never  do  it  to  purpose.  There  the 
prophet  setteth  one  before  us,  in  his  royal 
iudicial  power,  in  the  person  of  a  king,  and 
of  a  king  set  down  to  execute  judgment ; 
and  this  he  telleth  vis,  before  he  thinks 
meet  to  tell  us  his  name.  Before  this  kina;, 
thus  set  down  in  his  throne,  there  to  do 
judgment,  the  righteousness  that  will  stand 
against  the  law,  our  conscience,  Satan,  sin, 
the  gates  of  heU,  and  the  power  of  dark- 
ness; and  so  stand  that  we  may  be 
•delivered  by  it  from  death,  despair,  and 
damnation ;  and  entitled  by  it  to  life,  sal- 
vation, and  happiness  eternal ;  that  is 
righteousness  indeed,  that  is  it  we  seek  for, 
if  we  may  find  it.  And  that  is  not  this 
latter,  but  the  former  only;  and  therefore 
that  is  the  true  interpretation  of  Jehovah 
justitia  nostra.  Look  but  how  St.  Augus- 
tine and  the  rest  of  the  Fathers,  when  they 
have  occasion  to  mention  that  place  in  the 
Proverbs,  Cam,  Bex  Justus  sederit  in  solio, 
quis  potest  dicere,  Mundum  est  cor  mewrn  ? — 
look  how  they  interpret  it  then,  and  it  will 
give  us  Ught  to  understand  this  name ;  and 
we  shall  see,  that  no  man  will  serve  then, 
but  this  name.  Nor  this  name  neither, 
but  with  this  interpretation  of  it.  And 
that  the  Holy  Grhost  would  have  it  ever  thus 
understood,  and  us  ever  to  represent  before 
our  eyes  this  King  thus  sitting  in  his 
judgment-seat  when  we  speak  of  this 
righteousness,  it  is  plain  two  ways.  1.  By 
way  of  position.  For  the  tenor  of  the 
Scripture  touching  our  justification  all 
along  runneth  in  judicial  terms,  to  admonish 
us  still  what  he  set  before  us.  The  usual 
joining  of  justice  and  judgment  continually 
all  along  the  Scriptures,  show  it  is  a  judicial 
justice  we  are  to  set  before  us.  The  terms 
of,  1.  A  judge:  'It  is  the  Lord  that 
judgeth  me.'  2.  A  prison :  Kept  and  shut 
up  under  Moses.  3.  A  bar :  '  We  must  all 
appear  before  the  bar.'  4.  A  proclamation  : 
'Who  will  lay  anything  to  the  prisoner's 
charge  ? '  5.  An  accuser :  '  The  accuser  of 
our  brethren.'  6.  A  witness :  '  Our  con- 
science bearing  witness.'  7.  An  indictment 
npon  these :  '  Cursed  be  he  that  continueth 
not  in  all  the  words  of  this  law  to  do 
them ; '  and  again,  '  He  that  breaketh  one  is 
guilty  of  all.'  A  conviction  that  all  may 
be  vttoSlkoi,  '  guilty '  or  culpable  '  before 
God.'  Tea,  the  very  delivering  of  our  sins 
under  the  name  of  'debts;'  of  the  law 
under  the  name  of  a  '  hand-writing ; '  the 
very  terms  of  '  an  advocate,'  of  '  a  surety 
made  under  the  law;'  of  a  pardon,  or 
'  being  justified  from  those  things  which  by 
the  law  we  could  not : ' — all  these,  wherein 
for  the  most  part  this  is  still  expressed, 
what  speak  they  but  that  the  sense  of  this 


KEYS 


425 


name  cannot  be  rightly  understood,  nor 
what  manner  of  righteousness  is  in  question, 
except  we  still  have  before  our  eyes  this 
same  coram  rege  justo  Judicium  faciente." — 
Bishop  Andrewes'  Sermon  on  Justification 
in  Christ's  Name.  See  also  Barrow's  Ser- 
mon on  Justification ;  Waterland  on  Justi- 
fi^cation;  Ji.6\xvt\ej  on  Justification  ;  Stanley 
Faber  ore  Justification. 


K. 

KATHARINE,  ST.,  VIRGIN  AND 
MARTYR  (of  Alexandria) :  commemorated 
in  our  Calendar  on  Nov.  25.  Very  little  is 
known  of  this  saint,  but  there  are  many 
legends  connected  with  her.  According  to 
tradition  she  was  of  royal  family,  and  gifted 
with  great  ability ;  so  that  she  confuted 
many  of  the  heathen  2)hilosophers,  in  the 
early  part  of  the  4th  century,  and  converted 
them.  They,  confessing  Christ,  it  is  said, 
were  burnt:  she,  a  beautiful  woman,  was 
subjected  to  the  solicitations  of  the  emperor 
Maximus.  Refusing  to  hsten  to  him,  she 
was  condemned,  and  put  to  death  by  torture 
on  ^a  spiked  wheel.  She  was  regarded  as 
the  patroness  of  secular  learning,  and  is 
represented  crowned,  with  the  martyr's 
palm,  or  a  book,  or  sword  in  her  hand,  and 
the  spiked  wheel  by  her  side.    [H.] 

KEYS,  POWKR  OF  THE.  The  au- 
thority existing  in  the  Christian  priesthood 
of  administering  the  discipline  of  the  Church, 
and  communicating  or  withholding  its  privi- 
leges. It  is  so  called  from  the  declaration 
of  Christ  to  St.  Peter  (Matt.  xvi.  19), 
"  And  I  mil  give  unto  thee  the  keys  of  tlje 
kingdom  of  heaven ;  and  whatsoever  thou 
shalt  bind  on  earth,  shall  be  bound  in 
heaven ;  and  whatsoever  thou  shalt  loose  on 
earth,  shall  be  loosed  in  heaven."  The 
power  here  promised  was  afterwards  con- 
ferred on  St.  Peter  and  the  other  apostles, 
when  the  Saviour  breathed  on  them  and 
said,  "  Receive  ye  the  Holy  Ghost.  Whose 
soever  sins  ye  remit,  they  are  remitted  unto 
them ;  and  whose  soever  sins  ye  retain,  they 
are  retained"  (Matt.  xvi.  19;  xviii.  18; 
John  XX.  23).  "Our  Lord  and  Saviour," 
says  Hooker,  "  giveth  His  Apostles  regiment 
in  general  over  God's  Church.  For  they 
that  have  the  keys  of  the  Kingdom  of 
Heaven,  are  thereby  signified  to  be  stewards 
of  the  house  of  God,  \mder  Whom  they 
guide,  command,  judge,  and  correct  His 
family.  Their  office  herein  consisteth  of 
sundry  functions,  some  belonging  to  dootiine, 
some  to  discipline,  all  contained  in  the  name 
of 'Keys'"  {Ecc.  P.ol.Vi.  4). 


426 


KEYS 


Bishop  Jeremy  Taylor  expresses,  ■with 
great  clearness,  the  primitive  doctrine  on 
this  subject :  "  The  same  promise  of  binding 
and  loosing  (which  certainly  was  all  that 
the  keys  were  given  for)  was  made  after- 
wards to  all  the  apostles  (Matt,  xviii.),  and 
the  power  of  remitting  and  retaining,  which 
in  reason,  and  according  to  the  style  of  the 
Church,  is  the  same  thing  in  other  words, 
was  actually  given  to  all  the  apostles ;  and 
\mless  that  was  the  performing  the  first  and 
second  promise,  we  find  it  not  recorded  in 
Scripture  how  or  when,  or  whether  yet  or 
no,  the  promise  be  performed."  And  again : 
"  If  the  keys  were  only  given  and  so  pro- 
mised to  St.  Peter,  that  the  Church  hath 
not  the  keys,  then  the  Church  can  neither 
bind  nor  loose,  remit  nor  retain,  which  God 
forbid :  if  any  man  should  endeavour  to 
answer  this  argument,  I  leave  him  and  St. 
Austin  to  contest  it." 

The  apostles  knew  nothing  of  any  different 
power  conveyed  to  one  of  their  number 
beyond  what  was  common  to  him  with  the 
rest,  as  we  may  reasonably  conclude,  since 
there  is  no  record  of  any  authority  exercised 
on  the  one  side,  or  of  obedience  rendered 
on  the  other.  The  proposed  distinction  is, 
indeed,  utterly  untenable,  and  the  whole 
testimony  of  antiquity  is  against  it ;  yet 
it  is  maintained  by  some  of  the  chief 
Roman  commentators  (See  Pope;  Papal 
Supremaay).  Maldonatus,  for  instance, 
who  is  one  of  the  best  known  and  most 
popular,  m  his  exposition  of  this  place, 
declares  the  keys  to  have  been  given  to 
Peter,  that  is,  the  power  of  binding  and 
loosing,  of  opening  and  shutting,  in  subordi- 
nation to  Christ  alone,  while  the  rest  of  the 
apostles  received  only  an  inferior  jurisdiction. 
For  this  interpretation  he  advances  no  proof 
at  all,  except  the  mention  of  the  keys  in  the 
address  to  Peter,  and  the  omission  in  what 
was  spoken  to  the  rest,  which  he  pronounces 
an  irrefragable  argument ;  and  on  the  founda- 
tion of  this  alleged  separate  gift  to  Peter  he 
builds  the  right  of  jm-isdiction  for  his  suc- 
cessors (assuming  that  he  was  bishop  of 
Eome),  extending  to  the  supreme  decision  of 
spiritual  causes  on  earth,  and  the  regulating 
the  condition  of  souls  in  purgatory.  Cor- 
nelius Van  den  Steen,  or  ii  Lapide,  as  he  is 
usually  called,  seems  to  have  followed  the 
interpretation  of  Maldonat,  and  says,  that 
by  the  keys  is  signified  the  power  of  order 
and  jurisdiction  granted  to  St.  Peter  over 
the  whole  Church ;  and  that  Christ  explains 
his  meaning  in  the  words  which  follow.  He 
falls  into  the  fallacy  of  representing  the  term 
"  rock  "  as  conveying  the  notion  of  govern- 
ment ;  and  then,  as  if  this  were  an  unques- 
tionably accurate  representation,  he  goes  on 
to  blend  figures  which  have  nothing  in 
common,  and  assumes  that  in  this  way  the 


KEYS 

supreme  power  of  the  pope  is  adequately 
proved.  Like  his  predecessor,  he  vindicates 
the  most  unlimited  exercise  of  it,  whether  in 
enforcing  obedience,  or  in  granting  dispensa- 
tions, _m  enacting  ecclesiastical  laws,  pro- 
nouncing excommunications  and  other  cen- 
sures, delivering  decisions  on  questions  of 
faith,  with  other  acts  which  fall  mider  the 
head  of  binding,  or  those  of  an  opposite 
character,  which  belong  to  the  power  of 
loosing.  In  order  to  dispose  of  the  difficvdt 
fact  that  Christ  is  recorded  to  have  given 
the  same  power  of  binding  and  loosing  to 
others  as  well,  he  affirms  that  Peter  was  first 
singled  out,  to  signify  that  the  rest  of  th& 
apostles  were  committed  to  his  care  as  his 
subjects,  and  that  he  was  empowered  to 
control,  hmit,  or  take  away  their  jurisdictions 
as  he  should  see  fit ;  though  it  is  clear  both 
that  the  apostles  exercised,  in  point  of  fact, 
the  highest  Church  discipline,  and  that  there 
is  not  a  word  which  implies  their  having 
done  so  by  delegation.  He  very  character- 
istically confirms  his  exposition  by  a  synodi- 
cal  letter,  which  the  great  Roman  annalist 
had  given  up  as  spurious  some  years  before. 
Both  these  writers  were  theologians  of  the 
highest  repute,  the  one  professor  at  Paris, 
the  other  at  Louvain.  They  may  be  fairly 
taken  to  express  the  judgment  of  the  party 
at  present  dominant  in  the  Roman  Church. 
Nothing  can  be  more  extravagant  than  their 
intei-pretations,  or  more  feebly  supported  by 
piroofs;  yet  they  are  indispensable  to  the 
position  of  the  ultramontanes.  This  extreme- 
doctrine,  revived  by  the  Jesuits,  for  it  was 
invented  a  century  earlier,  has  no  pretence 
of  confirmation  from  any  of  the  primitive 
expositors  of  Scripture.  They  declare,  with 
one  voice,  that  the  keys  were  given  to  the- 
Church  in  the  person  of  Peter.  In  the 
words  of  Ambrose,  "  what  is  said  to  Peter, 
is  said  to  the  apostles."  Cyprian  and  Origen,. 
Jerome  and  Basil,  are  of  one  mind  on  this 
point.  The  statement  of  Augustine,  repeated 
in  a  multitude  of  places,  is  as  clear  as  possible 
that  the  Church  received  the  power  of  the 
keys,  and  not  an  individual  apostle.  The 
Fathers  were  not  writing  with  any  view  to 
the  present  controversy ;  and  many  of  their 
expressions,  taken  separately,  would  give  a 
very  untrue  representation  of  their  meaning, 
by  making  them  maintain  opinions  which, 
in  their  time,  had  not  been  even  suggested. 
Thus  Cyprian,  in  his  treatise  on  the  unity 
of  the  Church,  applies  the  disputed  texts  to 
Peter ;  but  then  he  speaks  of  him  as  the 
type  of  unity,  the  representative  of  a  great 
principle ;  and  to  guard  his  meaning  against 
perversion,  he  states,  in  the  plainest  terms, 
that  the  rest  of  the  apostles  were  what 
Peter  was,  and  had  equ{il  participation  of 
honour  and  authority.  So  the  Fathers 
continually  speak  of  him  as  figm-ing  the 


KEYS 

oneness  of  tlie  Cliurcli  universal.  They 
exalt  his  chair,  but  they  are  careful  to 
explain  that  they  are  speaking,  not  of  an 
individual  bishop  possessing  supreme  autho- 
rity, -which  was  the  farthest  from  their 
thoughts,  but  of  that  one  undivided  episco- 
pacy, to  use  Cyprian's  well-known  words,  of 
which  every  bishop  possesses  a  portion. 

Dupin  aflSrms  that  the  Fathers  are  una- 
nimous in  assigning  ecclesiastical  power, 
either  to  the  Church  generally,  or  to  the 
apostles,  and,  after  them,  to  bishops ;  that 
there  is  not  one  to  be  found  who  holds  it 
to  have  been  given  to  Peter  and  his  suc- 
cessors alone ;  and  that  they  have  guarded 
against  any  wrong  inference  which  might 
be  drawn  from  the  promise  given  to  Peter, 
by  showing  that  he  was  regarded  as  the 
representative  of  the  Church.  He  fur- 
nishes some  authorities  on  this  subject,  not 
only  from  the  early  Fathers,  but  from 
popes,  great  bishops  of  the  Roman  Church, 
scholastic  writers,  and  universities;  and 
he  adds,  that  the  number  of  passages 
which  might  be  adduced  is  infinite.  The 
same  writer  states  strongly  the  importance 
of  the  question  :  for  if,  as  he  says,  the 
power  of  the  keys  belongs  to  the  pope 
alone,  there  can  be  no  doubt  that  he  has 
authority  over  the  whole  Church  ;  since, 
upon  this  hypothesis,  neither  the  Church 
nor  its  prelates  can  have  any  other  power 
than  such  as  they  derive  from  him. 

In  the  Council  of  Paris,  held  in  the 
eighth  century,  under  the  emperors  Louis 
and  Lothaire,  the  bishops  expressly  claimed 
this  power  of  binding  and  loosing,  without 
any  reference  to  the  successor  of  St.  Peter. 
The  Council  of  Constance,  in  the  fourth  ses- 
sion, declared,  in  the  strongest  language, 
that  the  Church  has  its  jurisdiction  imme- 
diately from  Christ ;  and  this  judgment 
was  embodied  in  acts  of  the  highest  sig- 
nificancy  and  importance.  The  Council 
of  Basle,  in  its  first  session,  passed  a  de- 
cree in  exactly  the  same  spirit,  and  almost 
in  the  very  same  words.  .35neas  Sylvius, 
the  historian  of  the  council,  and  afterwards 
Pius  II.,  expressly  vindicates  the  text  in 
question  from  the  interpretation  which 
favours  the  pontifical  authority.  So  Car- 
dinal de  Cusa,  writing  at  the  same  period, 
claims  for  the  other  apostles  the  very  same 
power  of  binding  and  loosing  which  was 
conveyed  to  Peter  by  the  words  of  Christ. 
And  John  Gerson  refers  to  this  very  place, 
in  maintaining  the  superiority  of  a  council 
to  a  pope.  Even  in  the  Council  of  Trent, 
we  find  the  Cardinal  of  Lorraine  speaking 
to  the  same  effect ;  and  though  he  may  he 
worthless  as  a  theologian,  he  is  valuable 
as  a  witness.  He  alleged  various  passages, 
from  Augustine  and  others,  in  proof  that 
bishops   derive  their  jurisdiction    immedi- 


KING'S  EVIL 


427 


ately  from  God.  And,  indeed,  the  whole 
argument  of  the  French  and  Spanish  pre- 
lates in  favour  of  the  divine  right  of  epi- 
scopacy was  based  on  the  very  interpretation 
of  our  Lord's  words  which  the  Jesuit  school 
condemns. 

The  canonists  bear  the  same  testimony. 
Thus  Van  Espen,  and  there  are  few  higher 
authorities,  delivers  it  as  the  doctrine  of 
the  Fathers  on  this  subject,  that,  while 
Christ  spoke  to  Peter  in  the  singular,  he 
made  conveyance  of  the  powers  in  question 
to  all  the  apostles  (i)e  Censur.  Eccl.  c.  2  : 
0pp.  trim.  iv.  ed.  Colon,  1777).  Duaren 
speaks  to  the  same  effect.  He  affirms  that 
the  power  of  binding  and  loosicg  was  given 
to  the  Church,  and  not  to  an  individual. 

Some  even  of  the  Roman  commentators 
give  a  similar  intei-pretation.  Thus  Nicho- 
las de  Lyra  says  that,  as  the  confession  of 
Peter  was  the  confession  of  the  rest,  so  the 
power  given  to  him  was  bestowed  on  all. 
D'Espence  and  many  others  give  the  same 
exposition. 

II.  In  the  Ordinal  of  the  Church  of 
England,  the  bishop  presiding  at  the  ordi- 
nation with  the  other  priests  present,  lays 
his  hands  on  the  several  candidates,  and 
says,  "  Receive  the  Holy  Ghost  for  the 
office  and  work  of  a  Priest  .  .  .  Whose  sins 
thou  dost  forgive  they  are  forgiven,"  &c. 
This  formula  is  thus  explained  by  Whitgift. 
"  The  bishop  by  speaking  these  words  doth 
not  take  upon  him  to  give  the  Holy  Ghost, 
no  more  than  he  doth  to  remit  sins  when 
he  pronounceth  remission  of  sins;  but  by 
speaking  these  words  of  Christ,  he  doth 
shew  the  principal  duty  of  a  minister,  and 
assureth  him  of  the  assistance  of  God's 
Holy  Spirit,  if  he  labour  in  the  same  ac- 
cordingly." 

Bishop  Wilson  also  states  the  position  of 
the  Church  of  England  with  regard  to  the 
power  of  the  Keys.  "Our  Church,"  he 
says,  "ascribeth  not  the  power  of  remis- 
sion of  sins  to  any  but  to  God  only.  She 
holds  that  faith  and  repentance  are  the 
necessary  conditions  of  receiving  this  bless- 
ing. And  she  asserts,  what  is  most  true,, 
that  Christ's  ministers  have  a  special  com- 
mission while  other  believers  have  not 
authoritatively  to  declare  His  absolution, 
for  the  comfort  of  the  penitents,  and  which 
absolution,  if  duly  dispensed,  will  have  a 
real  effect  from  the  promise  of  Christ." 

KINDRED  (See  Affinity;  Consan- 
guinity}. 

KING'S  EVIL.  A  term  formerly  de- 
noting the  disease  properly  called  "  scrofula," 
because  the  power  to  cure  it  was  for  many 
centuries  attributed  to  the  kings  of  Eng- 
land, and  was,  from  the  time  of  Edward  the 
Confessor,  held  to  be  exercised  as  a  part  of 
the  religion  attached  to  the  person  of  the- 


428 


KING'S  EVIL 


king.  The  cure,  too,  was  always  accom- 
panied by  a  religious  service. 

The  kings  of  France  also  claimed  the 
gift  of  healing  (but  upon  no  other  occa- 
sions than  at  their  coronation),  and  the 
ceremony  was  used  at  the  coronation  of 
Charles  X.  at  Eheims.  George  I.  made 
no  pretensions  to  this  gift,  and  it  has  never 
been  claimed  by  his  successors.  Probably 
the  latest  known  case  of  the  ceremony  was 
that  of  Dr.  Johnson,  who  was  "  touched  "  by 
Queen  Anne  when  a  child. 

In  Js^nuary,  1683,  a  proclamation  was 
issued  by  the  privy  council,  and  was  ordered 
to  be  pubhshed  in  every  parish  in  the 
kingdom,  enjoining  that  the  time  for  pre- 
senting persons  for  the  "  public  heahngs  " 
should  be  from  the  feast  of  All  Saints,  till 
a  week  before  Christmas ;  and  after  Christ- 
mas until  the  first  day  of  March,  and  then 
to  cease  tdl  Passion  week. 

The  office  for  the  ceremony  was  called 
"  TJie  Ceremonies,"  or  "  Prayers  for  the 
Sealing."  The  Latin  form  was  used  in 
the  tinje  of  Henry  VIL,  and  was  reprinted 
by  his  Majesty's  command  by  Hemry  Hills, 
printer  to  the  king,  in  1686.  The  English 
forms  were  essentially  the  same,  with  some 
modifications.  These  occm-  in  the  Common 
Prayer  Books  of  the  reigns  of  Charles  I., 
Charles  II.,  James  II.,  and  Anne  (and,  as 
it  appears  from  Mr.  Stephens's  own  state- 
ment, in  that  of  George  L,  in  1715).  They 
all  vary ;  and  a  new  one  appears  to  have 
been  dravm  up  for  each  sovereign,  so  late 
as  1719  (See  Pegge's  Curialia  Miscellanea, 
161 ;  taken  from  a  folio  Prayer  Book,  1710. 
Also  Kennet's  Register,  731,  and  Sparrow's 
Articles,  165,  printed  in  1684,  which  latter 
form  seems  to  have  been  used  in  the  reign 
of  Charles  I.).  In  Mr.  Stephens's  editions 
of  the  Common  Prayer  Book,  from  which 
the  foregoing  article  has  been  abridged,  the 
Latin  form  is  given  (i.  997),  and  the 
English  form  in  1715  (1002). 

According  to  the  rubrics  in  this  office, 
the  chaplain  repeated  the  words,  "  super 
aggros  manus  imponent,  et  bene  habebunt," 
as  long  as  the  king  was  handling  the  sick 
person.  And  afterwards  the  last  clause  of 
the  second  Gospel,  "  Erat  lux  vera,"  &c., 
was  repeated  as  long  as  the  king  was  cross- 
ing the  sore  with  an  angel  noble  ;  which 
angel  was  afterwards  given  to  the  sick 
person  to  be  worn  by  him.  If  he  lost  the 
coin  he  would  have  to  be  "  touched  "  again. 
— Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  Ang.  Ecc.  iii.  388. 

It  seems  that  in  some  of  Queen  Anne's 
Prayer  Books  (not  in  1715,  as  stated  by 
Mr.  Stephens,)  the  form  was  altered,  by  the 
omission  of  the  second  Gospel,  and  the  ad- 
dition of  certain  prayers. — ^L' Bstrange's 
Alliance  of  the  Divine  Offices,  1699. 

There  seems  to  be  little  doubt  that,  by 


KINGS 

the  mere  force  of  imagination,  a  cure  was 
not  unfrequently  occasioned. 

KINGS,  BOOKS  OF.  Two  canoni- 
cal books  of  the  Old  Testament ;  so  called 
because  they  contain  the  history  of  the 
kings  of  Israel  and  Judah,  from  the  be- 
ginning of  the  reign  of  Solomon  down  to 
the  Babylonish  captivity,  for  the  space  of 
near  600  years;  taking  into  the  account 
the  two  preceding  Books  of  Samuel.  In 
the  Greek  Bibles,  as  well  as  in  the  Latin, 
the  two  Books  of  Samuel  are  called  the 
First  and  Second  Books  of  Kings ;  so  that  in 
these  copies  of  the  Bible  there  are  four 
Books  of  Kings.  Anciently  these  four 
were  but  two  in  the  Hebrew  Bibles,  the 
first  whereof  was  called  Samuel,  and  the 
second  Kings,  or  Kingdoms:  but  at  pre- 
sent, in  the  Hebrew  copies,  the  first  of 
these  books  is  styled  the  First  and  Second 
Book  of  Samuel;  and  the  other,  the  First 
and  Second  Book  of  Kings,  as  in  our  English 
version  of  the  Bible. 

It  is  probable  that  the  two  Books  of 
Kmgs  were  composed  by  Ezra,  who  ex- 
tracted them  out  of  the  public  records 
which  were  kept  of  what  passed  in  that 
nation. 

KING'S  BOOK.  A  revised  edition  of 
the  "Bishop's  Book,"  which  bore  the  title 
of  "  A  Necessary  Doctrine  and  Erudition 
for  any  Christian  Man  "  (See  Articles). 

KINGS,  PEAYEE  FOE.  I.  St.  Paul 
enjoins  that  such  prayers  should  be  offered 
(1  Tim.  ii.).  And  at  a  very  early  date 
prayers  for  the  ruling  sovereign  were  intro- 
duced into  the  Liturgy.  The  Fathers,  fol- 
lowing the  apostoUc  injunction,  frequently 
refer  to  the  duty  of  Christians  in  this 
respect  (Tertul.  ad  Scapulam,  c.  ii. ;  St. 
Cyril,  Catech.  v.,  &o.).  The  hturgies  of  St. 
Basil  and  St.  Chrysostom  contain  prayers 
for  the  king,  and  such  prayers  are  to  be 
found  in  all  the  various  forms  of  the  offices 
of  the  Church,  both  in  the  East  and  West 
(See  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  ii.  902).  In  the 
Sacramentary  of  Gregory  there  is  a  "  Missa 
pro  Rege,"  and  in  the  daily  hour-offices, 
prayer  was  offered  for  kings. 

II.  At  the  Council  of  Clovesho  (a.d.  747) 
the  clergy  were  desired  not  to  neglect  to 
pray  for  kings,  and  for  the  safety  of  the 
Christian  Church  (Haddan  and  Stubbs, 
Cone.  iii.  367).  In  the  ecclesiastical  laws 
of  King  Ethelred,  a.d  1012,  express  di- 
rections are  given  that  a  certain  prayer 
should  be  said  daily  for  the  king  and  his 
people.  The  Salisbury  Missal  contauis  an 
exhortation  to  this  effect,  and  prayers  for  the 
king  and  queen  (Maskell,  Anc.  Lit.  p.  184). 
The  prayer  for  the  king  (or  queen),  as  it 
stands  in  our  Prayer  Book,  seems  to  have 
been  taken  from  two  books  ofprivate  prayer  : 
(i.)    "  Psalmes   or   prayers    taken    out    of 


KIEK 

Uolye  Scripture  "  (1545-1548);  (ii.)  Prayers, 
or  meditations  .  .  .  collected  out  of  holy 
works  by  the  gracious  Princess  Katherine, 
queen  of  England,  Prance,  and  Ireland,  Anno 
Dmi.  1547."  It  was  printed  in  the  Prymer 
of  1553  as  the  fourth  collect.  In  Queen 
EUzabeth's  reign  (1559)  it  was  jjlaced  in  its 
present  shape,  before  the  Prayer  of  St. 
Clirysostom,  at  the  end  of  the  Litany ;  and 
was  finally  settled,  as  we  now  have  it,  in 
ICCl.  The  collects  for  the  sovereign  in  our 
communion  office  appear  to  have  been  com- 
posed in  1549;  but  probably  they  were 
based  on  ancient  forms,  of  which  there  were 
a  great  number.    [H.] 

KIEK  OP  SCOTLAND  (See  Pres- 
ht/terians).  The  Elirk  of  Scotland  ac- 
knowledges as  its  founder  the  celebrated 
John  Knox,  a  disciple  of  Calvin.  From 
its  foundation,  it  adopted  the  doctrine  and 
ecclesiastical  government  of  the  Church 
of  Geneva.  In  1581,  King  James,  with 
his  whole  family  and  the  whole  nation, 
subscribed  a  confession  of  faith,  with 
a  solemn  league  and  covenant,  obliging 
themselves  to  maintain  and  defend  the 
Protestant  religion  and  Presbyterian  go- 
vernment. The  title  of  this  confession 
is,  "  A  General  Confession  of  the  true 
Chiistian  Faith  and  Religion,  according  to 
God's  "Word,  and  Acts  of  our  Parliament, 
subscribed  by  the  King's  Majestie  and  his 
Household,  with  sundrie  others.  To  the 
glory  of  God,  and  good  example  of  all  men. 
At  Edinburgh,  the  28th  day  of  Januarie. 
The  year  of  om-  Lord  1581.  And  in  the 
14th  year  of  his  Majestie's  reign"  (See 
Confessions  of  FaitK). 

KISS  OF  PEACE.  This  form  of  salu- 
tation, as  a  token  of  Christian  affection, 
appears  to  have  been  an  apostohc  custom 
(Pom.  xvi.  16 ;  1  Cor.  xvi.  20 ;  2  Cor.  xiii. 
12 ;  1  Thess.  v.  26 ;  1  St.  Pet.  v.  14).  The 
Fathers  also  frequently  refer  to  this  mode 
of  salutation.  Thus  Origen  speaks  of  the 
kiss  "  which  ought  to  be  holy  "  (in  Eom. 
xvi.  16) ;  Tertulhan  calls  it  the  "  seal  of 
prayei "  (.De  Orat.  c.  18)  ;  and  Augustine 
says  of  those  about  to  communicate  in 
the  Church,  that  "  they  demonstrated  their 
inward  peace  by  the  outward  kiss"  {De 
Amicit.  vi.).  But  care  had  to  be  taken, 
and  Clement  of  Alexandria  speaks  of  the 
"  shameless  use  which  was  made  of  the  kiss 
.  .  .  occasioning  evil  reports"  {Fmdagog. 
iii.  11).  The  Apostolic  Constitutions  order 
that  the  men  shall  only  kiss  the  men  ;  the 
women  the  women  (viii.  2) ;  and  this  rule 
was  enjoined  by  many  councils  and  canons 
(Labbe,  Cone.  i.  1500).  This  salutation 
was  used  especially  (1)  at  Holy  Communion, 
(2)  at  Baptism,  (3)  at  Ordination. — ^Bing- 
ham, 1.  12 ;  iv.  C ;  xii.  4 ;  xv.  1,  3 ;  Diet. 
Christ.  Ant.  904.     [H.] 


KOEAH 


429 


KNEELERS  {Oenuflectentes).  The  third 
class  of  penitents  in  the  early  Church. 
They  were  allowed  to  stay  in  the  church, 
and  join  in  certain  prayers  particularly  made 
for  them,  whUe  they  were  kneeling  upon 
their  knees. — Bingham,  xviii.  1. 

KNEELING.  The  ordinary  posture  in 
prayer,  confession,  and  devotion.  The 
example  of  kneeling  in  prayer  is  set  by  our 
Lord,  and  was  the  practice  of  many  saints 
mentioned  in  the  Old  and  New  Testaments 
(Ex.  XX.  5  ;  Ps.  xcv.  6 ;  1  Kings  viii.  54 ; 
Ezra  ix.  5-15  ;  Dan.  vi.  10 ;  Acts  vii.  60 ; 
ix.  40  ;  XX.  36,  &c. ;  St.  Luke  xxii.  41,  &c.). 
The  custom  amongst  the  early  Christians 
was  so  common  that  prayer  itself  was  often 
called  kKio-is  yovdrau,  and  Eusebius  relates 
of  St.  James,  bishop  of  Jerusalem,  that  "  he 
was  wont  to  pray  assiduously  on  his  knees 
(icei/xfj'oj  eVi  Tois  yovacri),  making  inter- 
cession for  the  sins  of  the  people,  till  his 
knees  were  grown  hard  and  callous  as 
those  of  camels  (Euseb.  i.  ii.  c.  23).  But 
in  the  primitive  times  kneeUng  at  prayers 
on  the  Lord's  day  was  prohibited.  "We 
count  it  unlawful,"  says  Tertullian,  "to 
worship  kneeling  (de  geniculis  adorare)  on 
the  Lord's  day ;  and  we  rejoice  in  the  same 
immunity  from  the  day  of  the  Pasch  till 
Pentecost "  (De  Coron,  Nul.  c.  3).  And 
this  custom  was  made  a  rule  by  the  Council 
of  Nice  (can.  20) ;  but  kneeling  at  other 
times  was  strictly  observed.  And  in  fact  it 
does  not  appear  that  the  rule  of  not  kneeling 
at  those  particular  times  was  widely  ob- 
served. St.  Augustine  says  that  he  does 
not  know  (ignore)  about  the  standing  to 
pray  on  the  Lord's  days  {Ep.  119,  ad 
Jantiar.  c.  17)  ;  and  the  rule  was  certainly 
not  observed  in  the  Syrian  churches  (See 
Standing). 

In  the  Western  Church  kneeling  has 
been  always  the  posture  prescribed  for  acts 
of  confession,  of  jirayer,  of  reception  of  a 
blessing,  or  gift  from  God;  the  direction 
being  sometimes  emphasized  by  the  words, 
"  meekly  kneeling  upon  your  Itnees,"  as  in 
the  case  of  our  communion  office,  to  pre- 
clude the  idea  that  a  sitting  or  bending 
X^osture  may  be  used  as  a  substitute. 

The  Church  of  England  has  always  set 
great  store  by  the  retention  of  this  posture 
of  reverence,  especially  at  the  reception  of 
the  Holy  Eucharist. — Bingham,  xiii.  8; 
Wheatly,  311 ;  E.  Daniel,  327.     [H.] 

KNELL.     A  bell  tolled  at  funerals. 

KORAH,  SONGS  OB  PSALMS  OF 
THE  SONS  OF.  The  "sons  of  Korah" 
formed  one  of  the  three  choirs  of  the  temple, 
all  Levites.  They  are  sometimes  called 
Korhites,  or  Kohathites,  being  descended 
from  Kohath,  the  second  son  of  Levi ; 
Kohath's  grandson  being  Korah.  Heman 
was  the  director  of  this  choir  in  the  time  of 


430 


KYEIE  ELEISON 


King  David :  but  it  seems  not  to  have  sur- 
vived the  captivity,  as  the  sons  of  Asaph  are 
alone  named  by  Nehemiah.  Twelve  psalms 
are  inscribed  Psalms  or  Songs  of  the  Sons  of 
Korah;  and  are  supposed  to  have  been 
specially  performed  by  that  choir,  or  com- 
posed by  some  of  its  members.  They  are 
the  forty-second  to  the  forty-ninth,  eighty- 
fourth,  eighty-fifth,  eighty-seventh,  and 
eighty-eighth.— Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible,  s.  v. 
Korahite. 

KYRIE  ELEISON.  Kiipif  iXirjirov: 
Lord,  have  mercy.  A  form  of  supplication 
frequently  used  in  the  services  of  the  Church. 
It  is  found  in  all  the  ancient  liturgies,  being 
repeated  sometimes  before,  sometimes  after 
certain  prayers.  It  was  customary  to  say  it 
three  times,  as  it  was  addressed  to  the 
Father,  Son,  and  Holy  Ghost.  For  this 
reason,  in  the  Western  Church,  the  second 
invocation  was  changed  to  "  Christe  Eleison," 
but  this  was  never  used  in  the  Eastern 
Church  (Martene,  de  Ant.  Ecd.  Bit.  i., 
iv.  3).  The  fonn  of  supplication  was  in 
early  times  known  by  the  name  of  the 
lesser  Litany;  and  to  this  probably  SS. 
Cyprian,  Chrysostom,  Augustine,  and  others 
refer  when  they  speak  of  litanies.  The 
Ambrosian  Eite  recites  the  Kyrie  three 
times  after  the  "  Gloria  in  Excelsis,"  the 
Gospel,  and  the  end  of  the  Mass ;  but  in  the 
11th  century  it  was  sung  nine  times.  In 
the  Salisbury  Portiforium,  as  in  the  other 
"  Uses  "  of  the  English  Church,  it  was  un- 
translated. It  was  threefold  before  the 
Lord's  Prayer  at  Lauds,  though  ninefold  at 
Prime.  In  the  first  Prayer  Book  of  Edward 
VI.,  following  the  Sarum  Use,  the  collect 
for  Purity  in  the  Communion  office  was 
followed  by  the  Introit,  and  then  came  the 
Kyrie  nine  times.  Sometimes  the  Kyrie  was 
expanded  in  a  sort  of  chant,  the  first  three 
lines  beginning  with  "  Kyrie,"  and  ending 
with  "  Eleison  " — as  for  example : 

*' Kyrie,  Rex  geuitor,  ingenite,  vera  eBsentia,  Eleison, 
Kyrie,  luminis  fons,  rerumque  conditor,  Eleison. 
Kyrie,  qui  nos  tuse  imagiais  signasti  specie,  Eleison." 

The  next  three  lines  beginning  "  Christe,' 
and  ending  "Eleison";  and  the  last  three 
beginning  "  Kyrie,"  referring  to  the  special 
work  cf  the  Holy  Spirit,  and  ending  as  before 
with  "Eleison."  In  our  Prayer  Book  the 
Greek  words  are  translated,  and  generally 
precede  the  Lord's  Prayer,  but  not  when 
that  prayer  is  used  in  the  euoharistic  office. 
For  "  it  is  to  the  prayer  what  the  Gloria 
Patri  is  to  the  praise  of  the  whole  office ;  a 
prayer  setting  forth  the  tone,  and  fixing  the 
object  of  all  the  rest,  and  being  addressed 
to  the  Holy  Trinity." — Bingham,  xiii.  1 ; 
Neale's  Prim.  Lit.  p.  88 ;  Freeman's  Prine. 
Div.  Serv.  i.  363 ;  Maskell,  Anc.  Liturg. 
p.  23 ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  s.  v.  Litany.  [H.] 
KYRIE,  "0  Lord"  (in  Charch  music). 


LAITY 

the  vocative  of  the  Greek  word  signifying 
Lord,  with  which  word  all  the  musical 
masses  in  the  Church  of  Rome  commence, 
that  is,  the  above-mentioned  Kyrie  Eleison. 
In  the  Church  of  England  it  is  generally 
applied  to  the  responses  between  the  com- 
mandments in  our  Prayer  Book. 


LABARUM.  The  celebrated  imjDerial 
standard  used  by  Constantine  the  Great. 
It  was  known  in  the  Roman  army  before, 
being  the  ordinary  standard  of  the  cavalry, 
but  that  of  Constantine  differed  in  its 
symbols  and  decorations.  The  dream  or 
vision  in  which  Constantine,  the  night  before 
the  last  battle  against  Maxentius,  saw  the 
celestial  sign  of  God ;  the  sacred  monogram 
of  the  name  of  Christ;  with  the  legend 
(ypdcf)!]!/),  "  By  this  conquer,"  is  minutely  de- 
scribed byEusebius  (de  Vita  Const,  lib.  i.  c. 
28-31);  who  also  gives  an  account  of  the 
Labarum  itself.  Near  the  extremity  of  the 
shaft  of  a  lance,  sheathed  in  plates  of  gold, 
was  affixed,  in  a  horizontal  position,  a  small 
rod,  so  as  to  form  the  exact  figure  of  a  cross. 
From  this  transverse  little  bar  hung  drooping 
a  small  purple  veil  of  the  finest  textm-e,  in- 
tenvoven  with  golden  threads,  and  starred 
with  brilliant  jewels.  Above  this  rose  the 
sacred  monogram  of  Jesus  Christ  encircled 
with  a  golden  crown.  Under  this  banner 
were  the  victories  of  Constantine  gained. 
It  was  carried  near  the  emperor,  and  de- 
fended specially  by  the  flower  of  his  army. 
The  etymology  of  the  word  is  utterly  un- 
known.— Gibbon,  Dec.  and  Fall,  cxx. ;  Canon 
Venables  in  Diet,  Christ.  Ant.    [H.] 

LAITY,  LAYMAN.  The  people  (Xaos) 
as  distinguished  from  the  clergy.  This 
distinction  was  derived  from  the  Jewish 
Church,  and  adopted  into  the  Christian  by 
the  Apostles  themselves.  As  the  offices  of 
the  priests  and  Levites  among  the  Jews 
were  distinct  from  those  of  the  people,  so  it 
was  among  Christians  from  the  first  founda- 
tion of  the  Church.  Wherever  any  number 
of  converts  were  made,  as  soon  as  they  were 
capable  of  being  formed  into  a  Church,  a 
bishop  or  a  presbyter,  with  a  deacon,  was 
ordained  to  minister  to  them,  but  the  laity, 
too,  says  Clement  of  Rome,  had  their  duties 
to  perform  "  6  Xa'iKos  avdpairos  to'ls  \cuKoii 
TTpocrrayiiacnv  SeScrat"  (ad  Corinth,  i.  40). 
Other  names  to  distinguish  the  laity  from  the 
clergy  were  used,  as  fiiariKol,  seculars; 
ifiiMT-ai;  but  the  most  common  was  laici 
(XaiKoi),  which  continually  occurs  in  the 
writings  of  Origen,  Cyprian,  Tertullian  and 
others  of  the  third  century. 


LAMBERT,  ST. 

Every  true  Christian  Church  is  a  body  of 
luen  associated  for  religious  jiurposes,  and 
composed  of  two  distinct  classes, — the  clergy 
and  the  laity  :  the  clergy  especially  and 
divinely  set  apart  for  sacred  offices;  the 
laity  exercising  the  duties  and  receiving  the 
[privileges  of  religion,  in  the  midst  of  tem- 
poral occupations  and  secular  affairs.  But 
the  clergy  are  thus  set  apart,  not  for  their 
own  benefit  only,  but  for  the  benefit  of  the 
Church  in  general,  of  their  lay  brethren 
among  the  rest ;  and  the  laity  also  are  bound 
to  employ  their  temporal  opportunities  not 
for  themselves  exclusively,  but  for  the 
Church  in  general,  and  for  their  clerical 
brethren  among  the  rest.  The  clergy  alone 
no  more  constitute  the  Church,  either  in  a 
spiritual,  in  an  ecclesiastical,  or  in  a  jjolitical 
sense,  than  do  the  laity  alone;  and  the 
Church  has  no  existence,  no  duties,  no 
rights,  except  as  it  is  composed  of  botli 
clergy  and  laity.  It  is  because  they  forget 
this  that  we  continually  hear  persons  speak- 
ing of  the  Church  as  if  it  were  only  an 
hierarchy,  and  of  "  going  into  the  Church," 
instead  of  Holy  Orders.  The  real  truth 
is,  that  the  Church's  privilege  and  authority 
belong  to  the  whole  body,  whoever  may 
be  their  immediate  recipients  and  executors ; 
and  whoever  maintains  them,  whether  he 
be  lay  or  clerical,  maintains  his  own  rights 
and  his  own  patrimony  (See  Lay  Baptism ; 
Lay  Friesthood). 

LAMBERT,  ST.:  Bishop  and  Martyr; 
commemorated  on  September  17.  He  was 
born  at  Maestri  cht,  and  brought  up  under 
Theodardus,  bishop  of  that  place.  On  his 
preceptor's  martyrdom  he  was  chosen  bishop, 
but  on  the  death  of  Chilperic  in  673  he  was 
driven  from  his  see.  He  was  restored  by 
Pipin.  There  are  two  accounts  of  his 
martyrdom,  (1)  that  he  was  slain  by  the  re- 
lative of  some  sacrilegious  robbers  whom  his 
friends  had  killed;  (2)  that  Pipin  himself 
caused  him  to  be  murdered  in  consequence 
of  his  boldly  rebuking  the  licentiousness  of 
that  prince. — Diet.  Clirist.  Biog.  s.v.     [H.] 

LAMBETH  ARTICLES.  Certain  articles 
so  called  because  they  were  drawn  up  at 
Lambeth,  in  the  year  1595,  by  the  then 
archbishop  of  Canterbury  and  the  bishop  of 
London. 

It  appears  that  towards  the  close  of  Queen 
Elizabeth's  reign,  the  errors  of  Calvinism 
had  spread  among  the  clergy  of  the  Chm-ch 
of  England.  These  errors  were  opposed  by 
.some  of  the  most  learned  divines  of  Cam- 
bridge. But  the  opponents  of  Calvinism 
were  denounced  as  persons  addicted  to 
Popery ;  and  the  heads  of  houses  ventured 
to  censure  one  divine  because  he  denied 
some  points  of  Calvinistic  doctrine,  and 
spoke  disrespectfully  of  Calvin,  Peter  Martyr, 
and   others.      Archbishop    Whitgift,    and 


LAMBETH  ARTICLES 


431 


some  other  bishops,  were  inclined  to  take 
part  with  the  heads  of  houses  at  Cambrido-e 
and,  adhering  to  the  popular  side,  to  con- 
demn the  orthodox  divines.  They  met  to- 
gether at  Lambeth  Palace,  and  there  Arch- 
bishop Whitgift,  Dr.  Vaughan,  elect  of 
Bangor,  Dr.  Fletcher,  elect  of  London,  Dr. 
Tyndall,  dean  of  Ely,  and  the  Calvinistic 
divines  from  Cambridge,  digested  under  the 
nine  following  heads  what  are  called  the 
Lambeth  Articles. 

"  1.  God  hath  from  eternity  predestinated 
certain  persons  to  life,  and  hath  reprobated 
certain  persons  unto  death.  2.  The  moving 
or  efficient  cause  of  predestination  unto  life 
is  not  the  foresight  of  faith,  or  of  persever- 
ance, or  of  good  works,  or  of  anything  that 
is  in  the  persons  predestinated;  but  the 
alone  will  of  God's  good  pleasure.  3.  The 
predestinate  are  a  predetermined  and  certain 
number,  which  can  neither  be  lessened  nor 
increased.  4.  Such  as  are  not  predestinated  to 
salvation  shall  inevitably  be  condemned  on 
account  of  their  sins.  5.  The  true,  lively, 
and  justifying  faith,  and  the  spirit  of  God 
justifying,  is  not  extinguished,  doth  not 
utterly  fail,  doth  not  vanish  away  in  the 
elect,  either  finally  or  totally.  6.  A  true 
believer,  that  is,  one  who  is  endued  with 
justifying  faith,  is  certified  by  the  full  as- 
surance of  faith  that  his  sins  are  forgiven, 
and  that  he  shall  be  everlastingly  saved  by 
Christ.  7.  Saving  grace  is  not  allowed,  is 
not  imparted,  is  not  granted  to  all  men,  by 
which  they  may  be  saved  if  they  will.  8. 
No  man  is  able  to  come  to  Christ,  unless  it 
be  given  him,  and  unless  the  Eather  draw 
him ;  and  all  men  are  not  drawn  by  the 
Father,  that  they  may  come  to  his  Son. 
9.  It  is  not  in  the  will  or  power  of  every  man 
to  be  saved." 

These  articles,  asserting  the  most  offensive 
of  the  Calvinistic  positions,  were  not  ac- 
cepted bj'  the  Church,  and  consequently 
were  of  no  authority,  although  they  were 
employed  at  the  time  to  silence  those  by 
authority  against  whom  argument  could  not 
prevail.  The  prelates  who  drew  them  up 
acted  without  authority,  for  they  were  not 
assembled  in  a  synod.  A  synod  is  an 
assembly  of  bishops  and  presbyters  duly 
convened.  In  this  instance  there  was  no  con- 
vention. The  meeting  was  a  mere  private 
conference ;  and  the  decision  was  of  no  more 
weight  than  the  charge  of  a  bishop  deUvered 
without  a  consultation  with  his  clergy,  which 
is  only  the  expression  of  a  private  opiruon. 
There  can  be  no  greater  proof  of  the  absence  of 
Calvinism  from  the  Thirty-nine  Articles 
thau  the  fact,  that  the  very  persons  who 
were  condemning  the  orthodox  for  innova- 
tion, were  compelled  to  invent  new  articles 
before  they  could  make  our  Church  Calvin- 
istic.    The  conduct  of  the  archbishop  gave 


432 


LAMBETH  DEGEEES 


much  offence  to  many  pious  persons,  and 
especially  to  the  queen ;  and  this  attempt 
to  iutioduce  Calvinism  into  our  Chuich 
entirely  failed. 

LAMBETH  DEGREES.  The  popular 
designation  given  to  degrees  conferred  by 
the  archbishop  of  Canterbury,  who  has  the 
]jower  of  giving  degrees  in  any  of  the 
faculties.  This  is  supposed  to  be  a  relic  of 
legatine  or  papal  authority  (See  ITood). 

LAMENTATIONS  OF  JEREMIAH. 
A  canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament 
(See  Jeremiah).  It  is  a  kind  of  funeral 
elegy  on  the  death  of  the  good  king  Josiah. 
St.  Jerome  imagines  that  the  prophet  la- 
ments the  loss  of  Josiah,  as  the  beginning 
of  those  calamities  which  followed :  accord- 
ingly he  prophetically  bewails  the  miserable 
state  of  the  Jews,  and  the  destruction  of 
Jerusalem ;  though  some  are  of  opinion  the 
Lamentations  were  composed  after  the  taking 
of  Jerusalem.  The  first  four  chapters  are 
in  acrostic  verse,  aud  abecedary  ;  every  verse 
or  couplet  beginning  with  one  of  the  letters 
of  the  Hebrew  alphabet,  in  their  alphabetical 
order.  There  is  a  preface  to  the  Lamentations 
of  Jeremiah,  in  the  Greek,  and  in  the  Vulgar 
Latin,  which  is  not  in  the  Hebrew,  nor  in 
the  Chaldee  Paraphrase,  nor  in  the  Syriac 
(See  SpeaJcer's  Commentary ;  Wordsworth's 
Old  Testament). 

LAMMAS  DAY  :  observed  in  the  Calen- 
dar of  the  Church  of  England  on  Aug.  1. 
It  is  called  in  the  Roman  Church  the  Festi- 
val of  St.  Peter  "  ad  viucula  " — in  the  fetters. 
In  the  Greek  Church  the  Festival  of  St. 
Peter's  chains  or  fetters,  commemorating  the 
imprisonment  of  the  Apostle,  and  his  de- 
liverance, is  held  on  Jan.  16,  but  neither  of 
these  dates  represent  the  actual  time  of  the 
event,  as  it  took  place  shortly  before  Easter 
(Acts  xii.  4).  Probably  the  date  in  each 
case  has  reference  to  the  dedication  of  a 
church  in  memory  of  the  event  (Diet.  Christ. 
Ant.  s.v.  Peter).  The  story  is  that  Eudoxia, 
the  wife  of  Theodosius,  having  obtained  at 
Jertisalem  the  chains  which  St.  Peter  wore, 
sent  them  to  the  bishop  of  Rome,  who  placed 
them  in  a  church  built  in  honour  of  the 
Apostle ;  and  Theodosius  decreed  that  Aug.  1, 
which  had  been  celebrated  in  memory  of 
Augustus  Caesar,  should  from  that  time  be 
observed  in  honour  of  St.  Peter.  From  this 
came  the  fanciful  derivation  of  the  word 
"  Lammas."  As  the  injunction  had  been 
given  to  St.  Peter,  "  Feed  my  lambs,"  it 
was  supposed  that  this  was  Lambmass  day. 
In  the  fifteenth  century  this  apparently 
was  accepted,  as  in  the  "Promptorium 
parvulorum "  the  definition  is  given : 
"  Lammesse  :  festum  agnorum,  vel  festum  ad 
vincula  S'  Petri."  But  the  true  definition  is 
"  Llaf-masse,"  contracted  in  the  chronicle  to 
"  Llam-masse  " ;  that  is,  the  loaf  mass.     In 


LANTERN 

the  Sarum  Manual  it  is  called  "  Benedictio- 
novorum  fructuum."  It  was  an  early  custom 
to  offer  on  this  day  an  oblation  of  loaves,  as- 
the  first  fruits  of  the  new  com.     [H.] 

LAMPADARY.  An  officer  in  the  an- 
cient Church  of  Constantinople;  so  called 
because  it  was  his  business  to  see  that  the 
lamps  of  the  church  were  lighted,  and  to 
carry  a  taper  before  the  emijeror,  the  em- 
press, and  the  patriarch,  when  they  went  to 
church,  or  in  procession. 

LANTERN.  The  central  tower  of  a 
cross  church,  when  it  is  open  over  the  cross,. 
This  seems  always  to  have  been  the  ver- 
nacular term  for  such  a  tower.  Thus, 
William  de  Chambre  says  of  Bishop  Skir- 
law,  "  Magnam  partem  campanilis,  vulgo 
lantern,  ministerii  Ehoracensis  construxit." 

The  principal  lanterned  towers  now  in 
England  are  of  the  following  heights  from 
the  floor,  and  in  every  case  the  lantern 
includes  only  one  story  above  the  general 
roofs,  whether  its  windows  are  high  or 
low.  The  towers  of  York,  Winchester, 
and  Peterborough  have  only  one  such 
story  altogether.  The  York  lantern  is 
187  ft.  high;  Durham,  153  (to  the  bell- 
floor)  ;  Peterborough,  138 ;  Canterbury,  136  ; 
Winchester,  135 ;  Boston  (not  a  central 
tower),  133 ;  Norwich,  120 ;  St.  Alban's,  103. 
A  few  parish  churches  have  genuine  lanterns 
of  considerable  height,  such  as  Doncaster 
and  Ludlow,  and  others  have  a  lower  kind 
of  lantern  produced  by  means  of  small  win- 
dows in  the  spandrils  of  the  tower  arches 
below  the  roof  ridges,  as  at  Hereford,  Hedon, 
and  St.  Paul's,  Burton.  In  some  churches 
the  bell-ringing  has  been  spoilt  in  recent 
times  by  architects  taking  away  the  belfry 
or  ringing  floor  in  order  to  throw  the  win- 
dows into  the  church  as  a  lantern.  Hereford 
and  Ludlow  are  very  bad  cases  of  that  kind, 
the  ringers  being  sent  up  into  a  dark  hole 
just  under  the  bells,  where  proper  riuging  is 
impossible.  At  Pershore,  Sir  G.  Scott  in- 
geniously made  the  belfiy  floor  a  kind  of 
square  island  set  diagonally  so  that  light 
comes  down  the  empty  corners.  At  How- 
den  and  Merton  College  chapel,  it  is  done 
the  reverse  way  by  making  only  a  ringing 
gallery,  which  is  rather  dangerous.  It  is  the 
same  at  Durham,  and  always  has  been ;  but 
probably  no  ringing  peal  was  intended  when 
the  gallery  was  built. 

The  term  lantern  is  also  applied  to  a 
narrower  structure  than  the  tower,  set  on 
the  top  of  it,  or  of  a  dome.  At  Ely  (West) 
and  Boston,  the  lanterns  were  probably 
made  for  lighthouses  or  landmarks  for  the 
fens,  and  at  Peterborough  too,  where  an 
ugly  wooden  octagon  was  added  in  Perpen- 
dicular times,  and  remained  till  this  century, 
when  it  was  removed,  and  Dean  Kipling's 
turrets  added   soon  after.     The  history  of 


LAPSE 

that  tower  is  both  curious  and  lamentaWc. 
The  original  was  a  great  Norman  tower, 
51  ft.  square,  of  "  tres  historias "  (a  funny 
bit  of  English-Latin).  In  tlie  14th  century 
it  was  threatening  to  fall,  as  many  of  the 
Norman  towers  did.  They  took  down  the 
two  upper  stories,  and  began  building  a 
Decorated  one  over  the  old  Norman  arches 
and  lantern  story  something  like  Norwich, 
of  which  sufficient  remains  were  found 
lately  to  have  enabled  it  to  be  restored. 
Then  they  found  it  would  not  bear  even 
that,  and  so  they  pulled  down  their  own 
work,  and  began  again  lower  down,  and 
made  new  pointed  great  arches  E.  and  W., 
leaving  the  Norman  ones  N.  and  S.,  and 
buUt  the  low  Decorated  story  on  them, 
which  looks  as  if  it  had  been  squeezed  down 
into  the  roofs.  In  1883  it  was  found  that 
the  whole  tower  was  in  danger,  and  that  it 
was  necessary  to  rebuild  it  from  the  founda- 
tions. A  great  majority  of  the  committee 
of  subscribers  concurred  with  the  architect  in 
wishing  to  restore  the  Norman  work  in  con- 
tinuation of  the  piers  and  the  two  Norman 
arches,  at  least  as  high  as  the  open  lantern 
would  have  been,  and  then  to  rebuild  the 
Decorated  story  above  it.  But  a  majority 
of  the  chapter,  against  the  dean,  stopped  it, 
and  were  backed  by  Archbishop  Benson,  to 
whom  they  had  appealed.  And  though  the 
committee  were  masters  of  the  funds,  they 
had  not  the  spirit  to  stop  the  supplies,  and  so 
the  church  is  spoilt  for  ever  by  a  modern 
copy  of  an  accidental  mongrel  tower,  solely 
due  to  the  bad  state  of  the  building  in  the 
14th  century,  instead  of  doing  exactly  what 
the  Decorated  builders  tried  to  do,  but  were 
obliged  to  give  up  for  that  reason.    [G-.] 

LAPSE.  When  a  patron  neglects  to 
present  a  clergyman  to  a  benefice  in  his 
gift  within  six  months  after  its  vacancy, 
the  benefice  lapses  to  the  bishop ;  and  if  he 
does  not  collate  within  six  months,  it  lapses 
to  the  archbishop;  and  if  he  neglects  to 
collate  within  six  months,  it  lapses  to  the 
Crown,  against  which  no  lapse  runs. 

If  the  bishop  is  himself  patron,  or  if  he  is 
also  an  archbishop,  he  has  not  two  periods 
of  six  months,  but  only  one.  If  he  any 
way  vacates  the  see  before  taking  advantage 
of  a  lapse,  the  presentation  goes  to  the 
guardian  of  the  spirituahties,  who  is  gene- 
rally the  metropolitan,  but  not  for  either 
Durham  or  Salisbury,  it  seems.  When  a 
vacancy  of  a  benefice  occurs  by  the  act  of 
the  bishop,  he  must  give  notice  to  the 
patron,  and  lapse  only  runs  from  that.  In 
case  of  a  death,  the  better  opinion  seems  to 
be  that  the  patron  himself  must  take  notice 
of  it.  Some  books  say  also,  of  a  resignation ; 
but  that  can  hardly  be  so  unless  the  parson 
has  given  him  express  notice ;  for  resigna- 
tion is  to  the  bishop,  who  need  not  accept  it, 


LATERAN  COUNCILS 


433 


and  the  vacancy  certainly  does  not  occur  till 
he  does.  Where  the  presentee  of  a  lay 
patron  is  refused,  the  bishop  must  give  the 
patron  notice,  and  cannot  take  advantage  of 
lapse  unless  he  does;  but  the  time  runs 
from  the  vacancy.  But  if  an  ecclesiastical 
patron  presents  a  clerk  whom  the  bishop 
refuses  for  good  cause,  he  loses  the  presenta- 
tion altogether.  But  probably  that  only  holds 
when  the  patron  is  officially  ecclesiastic,  not 
accidentally.  A  quare  impedit,  and  proba- 
bly all  other  litigation  about  the  right  to 
present,  prevents  a,  lapse  till  the  suit  is 
decided,  at  any  rate  if  the  bishop  is  made  a 
party  to  it.  And  an  injunction  has  been 
granted  to  him  not  to  fill  up  a  living  in  an 
ordinary  Chancery  suit  about  the  title 
{Greenslade  v. Dare,  17  Beav.  502).  Some- 
times the  bishop  gives  an  undertaking  not 
to  avail  himself  of  a  lapse,  which  has  the 
same  effect  as  an  injunction,  and  probably 
also  prevents  time  from  running  in  favour 
of  the  Crown  or  the  metropolitan  in  such 
cases,  as  the  bishop's  delay  is  not  negligence. 
The  lapse  of  honoraiy  or  non-residentiary 
canonries  or  any  unendowed  dignity  or 
office  to  the  Crown  is  barred  by  the  Act  13 
&  14  Vict.  c.  98,  so  that  a  bishop  may  keep 
them  vacant  as  long  as  he  pleases,  as  they 
are  of  no  value.     [G.] 

LAPSED,  LAPSI.  Those  persons  were 
so  called,  who  in  time  of  persecution  denied 
the  faith  of  Christ,  but  again,  on  perse- 
cution ceasing,  sought  reconciliation  and 
Church  communion  (See  Persecutions). 
The  discipline  with  which  such  persons 
were  visited  included  a  long  absence  from 
the  Holy  Eucharist,  which  however  was  not 
denied  them  in  case  of  extreme  illness. 
And  the  maternal  solicitude  of  the  Church 
for  her  sons  was  so  great,  that  when  dan- 
gerous sickness  was  prevalent,  or  when 
another  persecution  seemed  to  impend,  it 
somewhat  relaxed  the  rule.  This  is  espe- 
cially shown  in  the  conduct  and  writings 
of  St.  Cyprian ;  in  whose  times  the  case  of 
the  lapsed  was  brought  before  the  Church, 
by  circumstances,  more  fully,  and  was  also 
more  clearly  determined,  than  it  had  been 
before.  One  of  his  most  celebrated  tracts 
refers  especially  to  their  case  (De  Lapsis). 
Different  circumstances  gave  to  different 
individuals  of  the  lapsed  the  names  of  Sa- 
crificati,  Tliurificati,  and  Lihellatici  (See 
these  words).  The  Traditores  were  not 
held  wholly  free  from  the  crime  of  the 
lapsed  (See  Traditors).  Those  who  ab- 
solutely and  for  ever  fell  away  were  classed 
by  the  Church  as  heathens,  and  had  of 
course  no  ecclesiastical  position,  however 
low. 

LAST  SUPPER,  THE  (See  Lord's 
Supper). 

LATERAN  COUNCILS.    L    The  Late- 

2  F 


431 


LATIN 


ran  council  in  chief  was  ^held  in  the  cliurch 
of  St.  John  of  the  Lateran  in  a.d.  649.  There 
were  five  sessions,  and  105  bishops  attended, 
ahnost  all  Itahans.  The  deliberations  were 
purely  doctrinal  and  anti-Monothelite.  The 
emperor  Constans  had  issued  an  edict  called 
the  "  Typus,"  which  was  intended  to  put  at 
rest  the  commotions  which  had  taken  place 
with  regard  to  the  one  will,  and  the  one 
operation  of  mil  in  Christ  (See  Monotlie- 
lites).  But  Pope  Martin  was  a  man  who 
sought  to  gain  a  reputation  by  metaphy- 
sical wrangling,  and  the  good  intention  of 
the  emperor  was  frustrated  by  this  council, 
which  condemned  the  "  Typus." — Mansi, 
X.  789-1188 ;  Harduin's  Cone.  tom.  iii. 
823  seq. 

II.  Other  councils  under  the  name  "  La- 
teran "  are  as  follows  : — 

Lateran  (J.)  in  the  year  1123.  It  was 
convened  by  Pope  Calixtus  II.,  who  pre- 
sided in  person.  More  than  300  bishops  were 
present.  It  ratified  former  Canons  forbid- 
ding simony  and  marriage  of  the  clergy,  and 
confirmed  the  "  Concordat "  of  Worms,  which 
settled  the  strife  about  "  Investiture  "  (See 
Investiture). 

Lateran  (IL)  in  1139,  composed  of 
nearly  1000  bishops,  under  the  presidency  of 
Pope  Innocent  II.  It  decided  on  the  due  elec- 
tion of  this  pope,  and  condemned  the  errors 
of  Peter  de  Bruys  and  Arnold  of  Brescia. 

Lateran  (iJ/.)  in  1179.  At  this  coun- 
cil, with  Pope  Alexander  III.  at  their  head, 
302  bishops  condemned  what  they  were 
pleased  to  call  the  "  errors  and  impieties  " 
of  the  Waldenses  and  Albigenses. 

Lateran  (JF.)  in  1215,  composed  of  412 
bishops,  under  Innocent  liL,  had  for  its 
objects  the  recovery  of  the  Holy  Land, 
reformation  of  abuses,  and  the  extirpation 
of  heresy. 

Lateran  (F.)  in  1512,  convened  by  Pope 
Julius  n.,  to  oppose  another  held  by  nine 
cardinals  of  high  rank  the  year  before  at 
Pisa,  with  a  view  to  bridle  his  wild  ani- 
mosity, turbulence,  and  contumacy.  It 
declared  that  council  schismatic,  abolished 
the  Pragmatic  Sanction  (see  Pragmatic 
Sanction),  and  strengthened  the  power  of 
the  Eoman  See. 

LATIN  PRATER  BOOK,  THE.  The 
first  Latin  version  was  made  in  1551  by  Aless, 
a  Presbyterian.  It  was  not  a  faithful  trans- 
lation, and  Bucer  was  by  it  much  misled 
(See  Aless).  This  book  was  revised  in 
Queen  Elizabeth's  reign  by  Haddon ;  but 
the  translation  differs  considerably  from  the 
English  Prayer  Book  of  Queen  Elizabeth. 
By  the  Act  of  Uniformity  (14  Car.  II.)  the 
use  of  the  Prayer  Book  in  Latin  was  allowed 
to  the  Universities,  and  "  colleges  of  West- 
minster, Winchester,  and  Eton,"  and  the 
convocations  of  the  clergy  of  either  province. 


LATITUDINAKIANS 

The  translation  was  carried  out  by  Arch- 
bishop Dolben,  Bishops  Earle  and  Pearson, 
and  Dr.  Durel,  under  the  supervision  of 
Archbishop  Bancroft,  and  it  was  published 
in  1670.  This  version  is  printed  among 
Bagster's  Polyglot  Prayer  Books,  but  the 
original  book  is  very  scarce  (Marshall  07i 
the  Latin  Prayer  Book  of  Charles  II.,  1882  ; 
see  Prayer  Book ;  Oblations).  A  complete 
Latin  version  of  the  Prayer  Book  was  pub- 
lished by  Canons  Bright  and  P.  G.  Medd,  in 
1865.     [H.] 

LATIN  FORM,  used  at  meeting  of  Con- 
vocation. This  consists  of  the  Litany,  a 
special  supplication  for  the  clergy,  a  prayer 
for  Parliament,  and  the  collects  for  these 
days — SS.  Simon  and  Jude,  Good  Friday 
(the  2nd),  St.  Peter,  and  5th  Sunday  after 
Trinity,  before  the  prayer  of  St  Chrysostom. 
This  form  was  first  printed  in  1700. 

LATITUDINARIANS.  Certain  divmes 
so  called  from  the  latitude  of  their  principles. 
The  term  is  chiefly  applied  to  some  divines 
of  the  seventeenth  century,  who  were  attached 
to  the  English  establishment,  as  such,  but 
regarded  episcopacy,  and  forms  of  public 
worship,  as  among  the  things  indifferent, 
and  would  not  exclude  from  their  com- 
munion those  who  differed  from  them  in 
those  particulars.  The  chief  leaders  of 
the  Latitudinarians  were  Chillingworth  and 
Hales.  The  latter  was  at  first  a  Calvinist, 
but  after  attending  the  synod  of  Dort 
changed  his  ideas,  and  went  to  a  very 
opposite  extreme. 

"  Why  may  I  not  go,"  asks  Hales,  "  if 
occasion  require,  to  Arian  churches,  so  there 
be  no  Arianism  expressed  in  their  liturgy  ?  " 
and  he  expresses  a  wish  that  there  should 
be  a  universal  liturgy,  comprehending  all 
ideas — then  schism  would  vanish.  But  he 
did  not  realise  that  the  life  of  schism  consists 
in  opposition.  The  first  Latitudinarians  took 
the  system  of  Episcopius  for  their  model, 
and  endeavoured  to  reduce  the  fundamental 
doctrines  of  the  Church  to  a  few  points. 
Their  object  was  to  show  the  contending 
parties  that  they  should  not  oppose  each 
other  with  such  animosity,  as  the  matters  of 
their  debates  were  of  an  indifferent  nature 
with  respect  to  salvation.  More,  Cudworth, 
Gale,  Whichcot,  John  Smith,  and  Tillotson, 
were  very  eminent  men  in  this  school ;  and 
in  later  years  there  has  been  a  large  party  in 
the  Church,  going  by  the  name  of  "  Broad 
Church,"  who  hold  the  same  opinions,  and 
are  in  fact  the  same  as  the  Latitudinarians. 
Professor  Maurice  observes  that "  this  school 
is  more  properly  Cartesian  than  Platonic, 
being  far  more  busy  about  the  soul  than 
about  its  objects,  and  therefore  in  their 
ethical  system  shding  into  the  Aristotelian 
doctrine  respecting  the  distinction  between 
the  absolute  and  the  practical ;  and  teaching 


LATRIA 

liow  to  fomi  habits,  rather  than  trust  in  prin- 
ciples."— Encyclop.  Metrop.  pp.  58-61,  246 
note;  Stubbs'  Mosheim,  iii.  379  and  620; 
Life  of  John  Hales,  and  of  Chillingworth, 
by  Peter  des  Maizeux,  London,  1719  and 
1725 ;  Burnet's  Hist,  of  his  own  times,  vol. 
i.  bk.  ii.     [H.] 

LATRIA.  The  worship  and  service  due 
to  Grod,  and  to  Him.  alone.  "  This,"  says  St. 
Augustine,  "  is  the  worship  which  is  due  to 
the  Divinity,  or,  to  speak  more  accurately, 
to  the  Deity;  and  to  express  this  worship 
in  a  single  word,  as  there  does  not  occur 
to  me  any  Latin  tenn  sufficiently  exact,  I 
shall  avail  myself  of  a  Greek  word.  Aarptla, 
whenever  it  occurs  in  the  Scripture,  is 
rendered  by  the  word  'service.'  But  that 
service  which  is  due  to  men,  as  servants  to 
their  masters  (Eph.  vi.  5)  is  usually  de- 
signated by  another  word  in  Greek  (SovXda), 
whereas  the  service  which  is  paid  to  God 
Alone  by  worship,  is  always,  or  almost 
always,  called  Xarpeia  in  the  usage  of  those 
who  wrote  from  the  divine  oracles"  {De 
Civ.  Bei,  x.  i.).  Roman  theologians  have 
made  a  further  distinction :  latria  is  as  above 
•defined ;  hypodulia  (uTroSouXcia),  the  honour 
due  to  the  human  nature  of  Christ,  and  to 
the  Blessed  Virgin ;  dulia  (SouXeia),  the 
honour  due  to  the  saints  (Thomas  Aqui- 
nas, Summa  Tlieol.  iii.  9,  xxv.  2 :  Secunda 
sec.,  quasst.  oiii.,  art.  iii.).    [H.] 

LATTER-DAY  SAINTS  (See  Mor- 
'inonists). 

LAUDS :  the  service  which  followed  next 
after  the  nocturn,  in  the  old  service  books. 
It  is  thus  explained  in  the  "  Mirrour." 
"  By  matyns  that  are  sayde  in  the  nyghte  ys 
understanded  the  olde  lawe,  that  was  all  in 
fygures  of  darcknesse.  And  by  laudes  that  ar 
sayd  in  the  morow  tyde,  ys  understonded  the 
newe  lawe  that  ys  in  lyghte  of  grace.  Also 
matin  es  betoken  the  heuynes  that  was  in  t3Tne 
■of  our  lordes  passyon.  And  the  laudes  be- 
token the  joy  of  his  resurrecoyon  "  (Fol.  Ixv.). 

The  lauds  are  now,  in  the  Church  of 
England,  merged  in  the  matins.     [H.] 

LAURA.  A  name  given  to  a  collection 
of  little  monastic  cells  detached  from  each 
other  but  ui  close  proximity,  and  generally 
clustered  round  a  church  as  a  common 
•centre.  These  loosely  connected  societies 
were  the  germs  out  of  which  more  organised 
monastic  communities  were  developed,  and 
form  a  kind  of  link  between  them,  and  the 
hermitages  of  solitary  ascetics.  The  most 
celebrated  Lauras  mentioned  in  ecclesiastical 
Iiistory  were  in  Egypt  and  Palestine ;  as  the 
Laura  of  St.  Pachomius,  St.  Euthymius, 
St.  Saba,  the  Laura  of  the  Towers,  &o. 
The  most  ancient  monasteries  in  Ireland 
were  Lauras.  The  origin  of  the  word  is 
very  uncertain. 

LAURENCE,  ST.:  Deacon  and  Martyr. 


LAVIPEDIUM 


435 


It  is  supiwsed  that  he  was  of  Spanish  birth  ; 
but  nothing  certain  is  known  about  his  early 
life.  He  was  ordained  deacon  by  Sixtus  II., 
and  appointed  chief  of  the  seven  deacons  of 
Rome,  and  Treasurer.  In  the  eighth  perse- 
cution both  the  bishop  and  his  archdeacon 
suffered  martyrdom,  a.d.  258,  the  latter  being 
slowly  broiled  to  death  on  a  gridiron.  To 
his  dying  intercession  Prudentius  ascribes 
the  final  conversion  of  Rome.  He  is  named 
in  the  earliest  Roman  Calendar,  a.d.  354 ; 
and  his  name  has  always  been  in  the  canon 
of  the  Roman  Mass.  He  is  commemorated 
in  our  Calendar  on  August.  10.     [H.] 

LAVABO  (Lit.  I  will  wash).  The  cere- 
mony of  washing  the  hands  of  the  priests  at 
the  celebration  of  the  Eucharist.  This  is  not 
done,  St.  Cyril  says,  so  much  for  the  pur- 
pose of  cleanliness,  as  for  the  symbol,  to 
which  David's  words  refer, "  I  wiU.  wash  my 
hands  in  innocency,  0  Lord,  and  so  will  I 
go  to  Thine  Altar  "  (Catech.  Myst.  v.  2). 
In  the  Roman  rite,  the  washing  of  hands 
occurs  after  the  oblation  of  the  unconsecrated 
elements,  before  the  most  solemn  part  of  the 
ofBce.     [H.] 

LAVACRUM.  A  name  for  the  cistern 
or  vessel  for  containing  the  water  for  baptism 
(See  Font). 

LAYER  OF  REGENERATION.  A 
term  adopted  from  Titus  iii.  5,  the  washing 
(\o\iTp6v)  or  laver  of  regeneration.  It  is  used 
in  the  certification  of  baptism,  in  the  office 
of  the  ministration  of  private  baptism  of 
children.  The  word  "  laver  "  is  derived  from 
the  Latin  "lavacrum,"  which  means  a 
vessel  used  for  ablution. 

LAVIPEDIUM.  The  ceremonial  washing 
of  the  feet.  I.  In  imitation  of  our  Saviour's 
washing  His  disciples'  feet,  persons  of  highest 
rank,  sovereigns,  cardinals,  bishops,  used  to 
wash  the  feet  of  the  poor.  The  day  was 
almost  always  Maundy-Thursday,  the  Thurs- 
day in  Holy  Week,  on  which  day  our  Lord 
performed  the  act.  The  custom  is  still 
kept  up  by  the  Pope  of  Rome.  In  England, 
not  to  mention  earlier  sovereigns,  we  read 
of  Queen  Elizabeth  performing  the  office  at 
Greenwich  in  1572,  when  she  washed  the 
feet  of  thirty-nine  poor  people,  the  number 
corresponding  to  her  own  age.  James  II. 
was  the  last  English  sovereign  who  con- 
formed to  the  custom ;  but  the  almoner  and 
his  assistants  in  dispensing  the  Royal  Bounty 
on  Maundy-Thursday,  are  still  girt  with 
towels  (See  Maundy). 

II.  In  primitive  times  it  was  sometimes 
customary  to  wash  the  feet  before  baptism. 
"  Many,  however,"  says  St.  Augustine, "  have 
not  accepted  this  as  a  custom,  lest  it  should 
be  thought  to  belong  to  the  ordinance  of 
baptism"  (JEpist.  lib.  v.,  cxviii.  ad  Jannar.). 
It  was  formally  forbidden  at  the  council  of 
Eliberis,  a.d.  305.    [H.] 

2  p  2 


436 


LAY  BAPTISM 


LAY  BAPTISM  (See  Baptism).  Baptism 
administered  by  persons  not  in  Holy  Orders. 
I.  In  the  early  Church  there  would  seem  to 
have  been  different  rules  at  different  places 
or  in  different  dioceses.  TertuUian  says  that 
laymen  have  the  power  to  baptize,  but  it 
should  only  be  exercised  in  emergencies  (De 
Bapt.  xvii.).  As  the  clergy — the  priests  and 
deacons — do  not  take  on  tliemselves  the  office 
of  the  episcopate,  so  should  laymen  not  take 
on  themselves  the  work  of  the  clergy,  except 
vrhen  there  is  necessity.  On  the  other  hand, 
Hilary  says,  "  neither  do  clerlis  or  laymen 
baptize"  (Hilar.  Diac.  Comm.  in  Ep.  ad 
Eph.  iv.  11).  So  also  the  compiler  of  the 
Clementine  Constitutions  prohibits,  laymen 
from  performing  sacerdotal  functions,  men- 
tioning among  them  baptism  (iii.  10).  A 
controversy  on  the  matter  took  place  between 
St.  Cyprian  and  Stephen  bishop  of  Rome 
(a.d.  255),  but  in  this  there  was  another 
point  at  issue.  St.  Cyprian  denied  the 
validity  of  baptism  by  schismatic  priests, 
and,  consequently  of  laymen  in  communion 
wich  them.  St.  Stephen  affirmed  that  the 
only  essentials  for  valid  baptism  were,  (1)  the 
right  matter  (water) ;  (2)  the  true  form  (in 
the  name  of  the  Father,  the  Son,  and  the 
Holy  Ghost);  and  that  thus  there  was 
valid  baptism  even  among  schismatics. 
"  There  were  three  views,"  says  Dr.  Pusey, 
"in  the  early  Church:  first,  that  of  the 
early  African  Church,  and  of  Asia  Minor, 
which  rejected  all  baptisms  out  of  the 
ihurch,  schismatical  as  well  as  heretical; 
second,  that  of  the  Greek  Church  generally, 
stated  fully  by  St.  Basil,  which  accepted 
schismatical,  but  rejected  heretical  baptism ; 
third,  that  first  mentioned  by  Stephen, 
bishop  of  Rome,  who  accepted  all  baptism, 
even  of  heretics,  which  had  been  given  in 
the  name  of  the  Trinity."  (Note  in  trans,  of 
Tertull.  p.  281.)  St.  Augustine  writes  very 
fully  on  this  subject.  The  chief  point  is 
that  the  minister  of  baptism  is  not  of  the 
essence  of  the  sacrament,  but  that  in  all 
cases  Christ  is  the  baptizer ;  thus  sanctioning 
lay  baptism  (In  Joan.  Evangel.  Tract  v., 
vi. ;  De  Baptism,  ii.  7,  53,  &o.).     [H.] 

II.  Anomalous  as  it  may  seem  that  one 
of  the  sacraments  can  be  validly  administered 
by  a  layman,  and  contrary  as  it  looks  to  the 
words  of  the  rubric  which  directs  baptism  to 
be  performed  by  the  "  minister  of  the  parish, 
or  in  his  absence  any  other  lawful  minister 
who  can  be  procured,"  it  is  certain  that  lay 
baptism  was  considered  valid  from  very  early 
ages  of  the  Church,  even  though  it  might  be 
irregular  and  the  performer  of  it  censurable, 
except  perhaps  in  cases  of  absolute  necessity ; 
which  probably  were  the  cause  of  it  being 
first  accepted,  even  when  performed  by  mid- 
wives.  And  it  is  now  settled  law  of  the 
Church  of  England :  Escoit  v.  Mastin  (Ecc. 


LAY-COMMUNION 

Judgments  of  P.  C.  p.  5.),  in  which  the  Dean 
of  Arches  and  the  J  udicial  Committee  both 
so  decided,  as  Sir  J.  NichoU  had.  before  in 
Kempe  v.  WicJces,  3  Phil.  276.  In  those 
judgments  may  be  found  a  full  history  of 
the  recognition  of  lay  baptism  in  all  ages, 
though  with  occasional  dissents  and  remon- 
strances which  never  prevailed.  Oddly 
enough,  it  was  the  Puritans  who  tried  in  the 
latter  part  of  Elizabeth's  reign  to  get  bap- 
tizing by  midwives  prohibited. 

The  ground  on  which  the  rubric  of  1662, 
which  first  introduced  the  words  above 
quoted,  was  held  not  to  prohibit  lay  baptism, 
was  one  familiar  to  lawyers,  that  a  repeal  of 
any  previously  existing  law  must  be  express 
to  be  effectual ;  i.e.  the  two  enactments  must 
be  incapable  of  standing  together.  A  direc- 
tion that  the  proper  minister  shall  baptize  is 
not  inconsistent  with  the  previous  law  that 
other  persons  might  do  it  in  case  of  necessity. 
It  was  therefore  held  that  a  clergyman  can- 
not refuse  to  bury  a  person  (whom  he  is 
otherwise  bound  to  bury)  on  the  ground  that 
he  is '  unbaptized,'  as  the  Burial  rubric  says, 
if  he  had  been  baptized  by  anybody  with 
water  and  the  proper  words,  '  in  the  name  of 
the  Father,  and  of  the  Son,  and  of  the  Holy 
Ghost.'  Of  course  a  dissenting  minister  is 
no  better  or  worse  for  that  purpose  than 
any  other  layman  or  a  midwife.  It  was  re- 
marked in  the  P.  C.  judgment  that  Arch- 
bishop Seeker  and  Bishop  Butler  had.  only 
had  lay  baptism.     [G.] 

LAY-BROTHERS,  are  the  servants  of  a 
convent. 

A  lay-brother  wears  a  different  habit  from 
that  of  the  "  religious  "  :  he  never  enters  into 
the  choir,  nor  is  present  at  the  chapters. 
He  is  not  in  any  orders,  nor  makes  any  vow, 
except  of  constancy  and  obedience.  He  is  em- 
ployed in  the  temporal  concerns  of  the  con- 
vent, and  has  the  care  of  the  kitchen,  gate,  &c. 

The  institution  of  lay-brothers  began  in 
the  eleventh  century.  The  persons  on 
whom  this  title  and  office  were  conferred 
were  too  ignorant  to  become  clerks,  and 
therefore  applied  themselves  wholly  to 
bodily  work,  in  which  they  expressed  that 
zeal  for  religion,  which  could  not  exert  itself 
in  spiritual  exercises. 

In  the  nunneries  there  are  also  lay-sisters, 
who  are  retained  in  the  convents  for  the  ser- 
vice of  the  nuns,  in  like  manner  as  the  lay- 
brothers  are  for  that  of  the  monks. 

LAY-CLERKS.  Olerici  Laid.  Singing 
men  so  called  in  the  statutes  of  the  Cathe- 
drals, founded  or  remodeled  by  King  Henry 
VIII.  In  general,  their  number  was  com- 
mensurate with  that  of  the  minor  canons. 
Lay-Vicars  are  sometimes  incorrectly  so> 
styled. 

LAY-COMMUNION.  The  tem  in  the 
first  place  implies  merely  the  participation  of 


LAY-ELDERS 

tiie  laity  ia  the  Holy  Eucharist ;  but  with  re- 
gard to  a  clergyman  it  had  in  early  times  a 
very  different  significance.  A  clergyman 
being  reduced  to  lay-communion,  meant  that 
he  was  totally  degraded,  and  deprived  of  his 
orders— that  is,  the  power  and  authoritj''  of 
his  clerical  office  and  function.  A  sentence 
to  this  effect  was  pronounced  upon  clerks 
who  had  been  convicted  of  heinous  offences ; 
and  was  very  seldom  remitted.  The  earliest 
use  of  the  expression  is  in  the  Council  of 
Elvira,  A.D.  305,  but  it  was  afterwards 
very  frequently  adopted. — Bingham,  ii.,  xvii. 
2,5.    [H.] 

LAY-ELDERS.  After  Calvin  had  settled 
the  presbyterian  form  of  government  at  Ge- 
neva, and  that  model  was  followed  elsewhere, 
laymen  were  admitted  into  a  share  or  part  of 
the  administration  of  the  Church,  under  the 
denomination  of  lay-elders. 

LAY-HELPERS:  LAY-READERS. 
I.  In  early  times  there  were  many  offices 
held  and  duties  performed  by  lay  persons 
in  the  Church  (See  Laity).  There  would 
appear  to  have  been  in  the  first  centuries  of 
the  Christian  a^ra  two  divisions.  The  first 
comprised  the  chief  men  in  the  place  or  diocese 
where  the  Church  was  settled.  They  were 
the  optimates,  the  magistrates,  or  the  elders, 
and  they  were  consulted  by  the  hisho|is  in 
matters  relating  to  the  management  of  the 
Church,  especially  with  regard  to  financial 
affairs.  St.  Augustine  calls  them  "  Seniores 
nobilissimi"  (Cone.  2  inPs.  xxxvi.);  and  they 
are  also  referred  to  in  a  council  of  Carthage, 
A.B.  403,  as  "  magistratus  vel  seniores  loco- 
rum."  The  second  consisted  of  those  who 
were  called  "  seniores  ecclesiastici,"  and  who 
were  entrusted  with  the  care  of  the  things 
of  the  church,  such  as  the  vessels,  or  orna- 
ments, and  also  had  certain  duties  given 
them  with  regard  to  instruction,  bringing 
the  people  to  the  worship  of  God,  render- 
ing assistance  at  baptisms,  maintaining  order 
amongst  those  who  came  to  church,  visit- 
ing the  sick,  distributing  alms,  &c.  Such 
persons  were  included  under  the  "Minor 
Orders,"  and  had  an  especial  Ucence  and 
benediction  from  the  bishop ;  but  their  work 
was  layman'.s  work,  and  the  actual  ordination 
was  not  required.  This  is  the  office,  and 
system  of  work  which  in  late  years  endea- 
vours have  been  made  to  revive. 

IL  In  the  mediaeval  times  the  monks  and 
friars  were  the  great  lay-readers,  and  helpers 
(see  Monies  ;  Friars).  When  English  moTias- 
teries  were  dissolved,  there  was  no  iTganiza- 
tion  to  take  their  place,  and  lay  help  became 
confined  to  the  churchwardens,  vestrymen, 
and  sometimes  sidesmen  (see  Sidesmen), 
and  was  only  nominal.  At  the  end  of  the 
17th  and  in  the  18th  century,  successful 
endeavour's  were  made  to  stimulate  the  in- 
terest of  laymen  in  church  work  by  societies 


LAYMEN 


437 


(see  Societies),  but  these  rather  gathered  and 
disjiensed  funds,  than  encouraged  personal 
service.  In  1857  the  Comiiuttee  of  the  Lower 
House  of  the  Province  of  Canterbury  pre- 
sented an  elaborate  report  on  lay  co-opera- 
tion, expressing  the  unanimous  opinion  that 
the  well-being  of  the  Church  greatly  depends, 
under  Almighty  God,  on  the  mutual  good 
will,  and  cordial  co-operation  of  its  members, 
clergy  and  laity.  Since  then  the  help  of 
the  laity  has  been  greatly  sought  in  diocesan 
confurenoes,  where  the  test  methods  of  em- 
ploying the  spiritual  gifts  of  the  laity  in  di- 
rect ministerial  work  as  lay  readers,  &c.,  have 
been  repeatedly  discussed.  In  several  dio- 
ceses associations  of  lay-helpers  have  been 
formed,  which  have  certain  rules,  and  meet 
annually.  In  1882  the  Bishop  of  Peterr 
borough,  in  the  Upper  House  of  Convocation, 
called  the  attention  of  the  House  to  this  mat- 
ter, urging  the  bishops  to  consider  the  rela- 
tion in  whicli  the  order  of  lay-readers  stood 
with  regard  to  other  orders  in  the  Church ; 
and  a  joint  Committee  of  both  Houses  was 
appointed,  which  gave  its  report  in  1884. 
According  to  the  resolution  a  reader  must  be 
a  communicant,  and  must  satisfy  the  bishop 
as  to  his  fitness,  &o.  He  must  sign  a  decla- 
ration of  acceptance  of  the  doctrine  of  the 
Church  of  England.  He  must  hold  the  li- 
cence of  the  bishop,  who  shall  admit  him  to 
the  office  by  the  delivery  of  a  copy  of  the 
New  Testament.  He  may  perform  services 
in  unconsecrated  places,  and  generally  act 
under  the  incumbent  in  visiting  the  sick, 
and  other  duties  (Official  Year-book,  1886, 
p.  111).     [H.] 

LAYMEN,  as  contrasted  with  clergymen 
or  "  clerks  in  orders,"  are  all  persons  who  have 
not  had  episcopal  ordination,  which  is  trace- 
able up  to  the  Apostles.  The  mere  fact  of 
any  sect  choosing  to  call  its  chief  ministers 
"  bishops,"  or  even  "  angels,"  goes  for  nothing. 
But  lawyers  are  in  the  habit  of  calling  all 
persons  laymen  who  have  not  been  "  called  " 
or  admitted  as  lawyers ;  and  so  may  every 
learned  profession  among  themselves  desig- 
nate as  laici  those  who  are  either  popularly 
called  anaateurs  or  altogether  outsiders  to 
that  profession,  not  professing  to  have  any 
special  knowledge  of  it. 

LAYMEN,  HOUSE  OP.  A  body  of  lay 
communicants  of  the  Church  of  England, 
the  members  of  which  are  appointed  by  the 
lay  members  of  the  several  diocesan  con- 
ferences, or  nominated  by  the  archbishop, 
to  confer  with  the  members  of  the  Con- 
vocation of  the  Province  of  Canterbury. 
Ten  members  are  appointed  for  the  diocese 
of  London,  six  for  the  dioceses  of  Winchester, 
Rochester,  Lichfield  and  Worcester,  and  four 
for  each  of  the  remaining  dioceses.  The 
nominations  by  the  archbishop  are  limited 
to  ten.     At  the  first  meeting  of  this  House 


438 


LAYING 


in  1886  the  archbishop  gave  the  following 
address  to  the  memhers : — ■ 

It  is  especially  in  regard  to  our  most 
serviceable  organizations,  and  to  those  legis- 
lative needs  which  have  necessarily  increased 
in  proportion  to  the  activity  of  the  Church's 
vital  and  spiritual  energies,  that  the  desire 
for  lay  counsel  has  been  manifested.  This 
d«sire  has  gathered  strength  for  many  years 
past  from  the  experience  of  that  counsel  as 
it  has  been  afforded  in  the  diocesan  and 
various  other  conferences.  The  Convocation 
of  Canterbury  has  now,  after  much  careful 
discussion,  requested  the  bishops  in  each 
diocese  of  the  province  to  call  upon  the  lay 
memhers  of  their  several  conferences,  who 
are  themselves  all  elected  by  the  laity  of 
the  parishes,  to  elect  a  House  of  Laymen  ia 
fulfilment  of  the  long-cherished  hope.  This 
House  is  therefore  a  body  purely  representa- 
tive of  the  laity,  and  its  realization  at  this 
day,  with  simpler,  freer,  larger  aims  than 
those  of  faction  or  political  party,  is  full  of 
strong  and  happy  promise.  The  moral  effect 
of  its  discussions  must  from  the  first  be 
great ;  and  we  cannot  doubt  that  if  its  con- 
clusions are  arrived  at  by  patient  debate  in 
fully  attended  meetings,  the  moral  effect 
will  in  due  time  take  material  and  practical 
form.  At  the  same  time  the  ancient  and 
actual  constitution  of  Convocation  imdergoes 
no  shade  of  alteration  by  reason  of  the 
existence  of  this  House.  This  House  will 
confer,  according  to  its  rules,  with  the  mem- 
bers of  Convocation  at  times  and  places  to 
be  appointed ;  will  deliberate  on  subjects 
submitted  to  it  as  well  as  originated  within 
itself  and  will  communicate  to  us  its  con- 
clusions. But  in  all  this  there  is  no  altera- 
tion in  the  character,  position,  or  duties  of 
Convocation.  Considering  the  constitutional 
basis  on  which  Convocation  has  rested 
through  centuries  of  our  national  life,  it  is 
obvious  that,  unless  its  unchanged  character 
were  expressly  secured,  or  if  it  were  attempt- 
ed without  legislative  sanction  to  make  this 
House  into  a  portion  of  Convocation,  Convo- 
cation itself  might  unawares  cease  to  exist 
(^Official  Year-book  of  the  Church  of  England 
1886,  p.  299.  Eccles.  Gazette,  March  15, 
1886).    [H.] 

LAYING  ON  OP  HANDS  (See  Im- 
position of  Sands). 

LEAGUE,  SOLEMN  LEAGUE  AND 
COVENAJSTT  (See  Confessions  of  Faith 
and  Covenant).  'Ihis  was  a  compact  estab- 
lished in  1643,  to  form  a  bond  of  union 
between  the  Scottish  and  English  Presby- 
terians. Those  who  took  it  pledged  them- 
selves, without  respect  of  persons,  to  en- 
deavour the  "  extirpation  of  Popery  and 
Prelacy,  (i.e.  church  government  by  arch- 
bishops, bishops,  their  chancellors  and 
commissaries,   deans,  deans   and    chapters. 


LEAGUE 

archdeacons,  and  all  other  ecclesiastical 
ofiScers  dependmg  on  that  hierarchy,)  su- 
perstition, heresy,  schism,  profaneness,  and 
whatever  shall  he  found  contrary  to  sound 
doctrine  and  the  power  of  godliness."  It 
was  approved  by  the  parliament  and  assem- 
bly of  divines  at  Westminster,  and  ratified 
by  the  General  Assembly  of  the  Scottish 
Kirk,  in  1645.  In  1650,  Charles  IL,  under 
compulsion  and  hypocritically,  declared  his- 
approbation  of  it.  The  league  was  ratified 
by  parhament  in  1651,  and  subscription 
required  of  every  member.  At  the  Kesto- 
ration  it  was  voted  illegal  by  parliament. 

The  following  is  the  document  which  is 
still  bound  up  with  the  Westminster  Con- 
fession, as  oije  of  the  foirmularies  of  the 
Scottish  Establishment,  though  the  minis- 
ters are  no  longer  obliged  to  sign  it : — 

The  solemn  League  and  Covenant  for 
Eeformation  and  Defence  of  Religion,  the 
Honour  and  Happiness  of  the  King,  and 
the  Peace  and  Safety  of  the  Three  King- 
doms of  Scotland,  England,  and  Ireland; 
agreed  upon  by  Commissioners  from  the 
Parliament  and  Assembly  of  Divines  in 
England,  with  Commissioners  of  the  Con- 
vention of  Estates,  and  General  Assembly 
in  Scotland;  approved  by  the  General 
Assembly  of  the  Church  of  Scotland,  and 
by  both  Houses  of  Parhament  and  Assem- 
bly of  Divines  in  England,  and  taken  and 
subscribed  by  them.  Anno  1643 ;  and 
thereafter,  by  the  said  authority,  taken 
and  subscribed  by  all  Banks  in  Scotland 
and  England  the  same  Year ;  and  ratified 
by  Act  of  the  Parliament  of  Scotland, 
Anno  1644:  And  again  renewed  m 
Scotland,  with  an  Acknowledgment  of 
Sins,  and  Engagement  to  Duties,  by  all 
Ranks,  Anno  1648,  and  by  Parliament 
1649  ;  and  taken  and  subscribed  by  King- 
Charles  II.  at  Spey,  June  23,  1650 ;  and 
at  Scoon,  January  1,  1651. 

We  Noblemen,  Barons,  Knights,  Gentle- 
men, Citizens,  Burgesses,  Ministers  of  the 
Gospel  and  Commons  of  all  sorts,  in  the 
kingdoms  of  Scotland,  England,  and  Ireland, 
by  the  providence  of  GOD,  living  under  one 
King,  and  being  of  one  reformed  religion, 
having  before  our  eyes  the  glory  of  GOD, 
and  the  advancement  of  the  kingdom  of  our 
Lord  and  Saviour  Jesus  Christ,  the  honour 
and  happiness  of  the  King's  Majesty  and  his 
posterity,  and  the  true  publick  liberty, 
safety,  and  peace  of  the  kingdoms,  wherein 
every  one's  private  condition  is  included : 
And  calling  to  mind  the  treacherous  and 
bloody  plots,  conspiracies,  attempts,  and 
practices  of  the  enemies  of  GOD,  against  the 
true  religion  and  professors  thereof  in  all 
places,  especially  in  these  three  kingdoms, 
ever  since  the  refoimation  of  religion ;  and 


LEAGUE 

liow  much  their  rage,  power,  and  presump- 
tion are  of  late,  and  at  this  time,  increased 
and  exercised,  whereof  the  deplorable  state 
of  the  church  and  kingdom  of  Ireland,  the 
distressed  estate  of  the  church  and  kingdom 
of  England,  and  the  dangerous  estate  of  the 
church  and  Kingdom  of  Scotland,  are  present 
and  public  testimonies ;  we  have  now  at 
last  (after  other  means  of  supplication, 
remonstrance,  protestation,  and  sufferings), 
for  the  preservation  of  ourselves  and  our 
religion  from  utter  ruin  and  destruction, 
according  to  the  commendable  practice  of 
these  kingdoms  in  former  times,  and  the 
example  of  GOD'S  people  in  other  nations, 
after  rnature  deliberation,  resolved  and  deter- 
mined to  enter  into  a  mutual  and  solemn 
League  and  Covenant,  wherein  we  all  sub- 
scribe, and  each  one  of  us  for  himself,  with 
our  hands  lifted  up  to  the  most  High  GOD, 
do  swear, 

I.  That  we  shall  sincerely,  really,  and 
constantly,  through  the  grace  of  GOD,  en- 
deavour, in  our  several  places  and  callings, 
the  preservation  of  the  reformed  religion  in 
the  Church  of  Scotland,  in  doctrine,  worship, 
discipline,  and  government,  against  our  com- 
mon enemies  ;  the  reformation  of  religion  in 
the  kingdoms  of  England,  and  Ireland,  in 
doctrine,  worship,  disciphne,  and  government, 
according  to  the  word  of  GOD,  and  the 
example  of  the  best  reformed  Churches ;  and 
shall  endeavour  to  bring  the  Churches  of 
God  in  the  three  kingdoms  to  the  nearest 
conjunction  and  uniformity  in  religion,  con- 
fession of  faith,  form  of  church-government, 
dii'ectory  for  worship  and  catechising ;  that 
we,  and  our  posterity  after  us,  may.  as 
brethren,  live  in  faith  and  love,  and  the  Lord 
may  delight  to  dwell  in  the  midst  of  us. 

II.  That  we  shall  in  like  manner,  without 
respect  of  persons,  endeavour  the  extirpation 
of  Popery,  Prelacy  (that  is,  church-govern- 
ment by  Archbishops,  Bishops,  their  Chan- 
cellors, and  Commissaries,  Deans,  Deans  and 
Chapters,  Archdeacons,  and  aU  other  ecclesi- 
astical OfScers  depending  on  that  hierarchy), 
superstition,  heresy,  schism,  profaneness,  and 
whatsoever  shall  be  found  to  be  contrary  to 
soimd  doctrine  and  the  power  of  godliness, 
lest  we  partake  in  other  men's  sins,  and 
thereby  be  in  danger  to  receive  of  their 
plagues ;  and  that  the  Lord  may  be  one,  and 
his  name  one,  in  the  three  kingdoms. 

III.  We  shall,  with  the  same  sincerity, 
reality,  and  constancy,  in  our  several  voca- 
tions, endeavour,  with  our  estates  and  lives, 
mutually  to  preserve  the  rights  and  privileges 
of  the  Parliaments,  and  the  liberties  of  the 
kingdoms ;  and  to  preserve  and  defend  the 
King's  Majesty's  person  and  authority,  in 
the  preservation  and  defence  of  the  true 
reUgion,  and  liberties  of  the  kingdoms ;  that 
the  world  may  bear  witness  with  our  con- 


LEAGUE 


439 


science  of  our  loyalty,  and  that  we  have  no 
thoughts  or  inteutions  to  diminish  his 
Majesty's  just  power  and  greatness. 

IV.  We  shall  also,  with  all  faithfulness, 
endeavour  the  discovery  of  all  such  as  have 
been  or  shall  be  incendiaries,  malignants, 
or  evil  instruments,  by  hindering  the  refor- 
mation of  religion,  dividing  the  King  from 
his  people,  or  one  of  the  kingdoms  from 
another,  or  making  any  faction  or  parties 
amongst  the  people,  contrary  to  this  League 
and  Covenant ;  that  they  may  be  brought  to 
public  trial,  and  receive  condign  punishment, 
as  the  degree  of  their  offences  shall  require 
or  deserve,  or  the  supreme  judicatories  of 
both  kingdoms  respectively,  or  others  having 
power  from  them  for  that  effect,  shall  judge 
convenient. 

V.  And  whereas  the  happiness  of  a  blessed 
peace  between  these  kingdoms,  denied  in 
former  times  to  our  progenitors,  is,  by  the 
good  providence  of  GOD,  granted  unto  us, 
and  hath  been  lately  concluded  and  settled 
by  both  Parliaments ;  we  shall  each  one  of 
us,  according  to  our  place  and  interest, 
endeavour  that  they  may  remain  conjoined 
in  a  firm  peace  and  union  to  all  posterity  ; 
and  that  justice  may  be  done  upon  the  wilful 
opposers  thereof,  in  manner  expressed  in  the 
precedent  article. 

VI.  We  shall  also,  according  to  our  places 
and  callings,  in  this  common  cause  of 
religion,  liberty,  and  peace  of  the  kingdoms, 
assist  and  defend  all  those  that  enter  into 
this  League  and  Covenant,  in  the  maintaining 
and  pursuing  thereof;  and  shall  not  suffer 
ourselves  directly  or  indirectly,  by  whatso- 
ever combination,  persuasion,  or  terror,  to  be 
divided  and  withdrawn  from  this  blessed 
union  and  conjunction,  whether  to  make 
defection  to  the  contrary  part,  or  to  give 
ourselves  to  a  detestable  indifferency  or 
neutrality  in  this  cause  which  so  much  con- 
cemeth  the  glory  of  GOD,  the  good  of  the 
kingdom,  and  honour  of  the  King ;  but 
shall,  all  the  days  of  our  lives,  zealously  and 
constantly  continue  therein  against  all  oppo- 
sition, and  promote  the  same,  according  to 
our  power,  against  all  lets  and  impediments 
whatsoever ;  and,  what  we  are  not  able  our- 
selves to  suppress  or  overcome,  we  shall 
reveal  and  make  known,  that  it  may  be 
timely  prevented  or  removed ;  All  which  we 
shall  do  as  in  the  sight  of  God. 

And,  because  these  kingdoms  are  guilty 
of  many  sins  and  provocations  against  GOD, 
and  his  Son  Jesus  Christ,  as  is  too  manifest 
by  our  present  distresses  and  dangers,  the 
fruits  thereof;  we  profess  and  declare  before 
GOD  and  the  world,  our  unfeigned  desire  to 
be  humbled  for  our  ovra  sins,  and  for  the 
sins  of  these  kingdoms  :  especially,  that  we 
have  not  as  we  ought  valued  the  inestimable 
benefit  of  the  gospel;   that  we  have  not 


440 


LECTERN 


laboured  for  the  purity  and  power  thereof; 
and  that  we  have  not  endeavoured  to  receive 
Christ  m  our  hearts,  nor  to  walk  worthy  of 
him  in  our  lives ;  which  are  the  causes  of 
other  sins  and  transgressions  so  much 
abounding  amongst  us:  and  our  true  and 
unfeigned  purpose,  desire,  and  endeavour  for 
ourselves,  and  all  others  under  our  power 
and  charge,  both  in  publick  and  in  private, 
in  aU  duties  we  owe  to  GOD  and  man,  to 
amend  our  lives,  and  each  one  to  go  before 
another  in  the  example  of  a  real  reformation ; 
that  the  Lord  may  turn  away  his  wrath 
and  heavy  indignation,  and  establish  these 
churches  and  kingdoms  in  truth  and  peace. 
And  this  Covenant  we  make  in  the  presence 
of  ALMIGHTY  GOD,  the  Searcher  of  all 
hearts,  with  a  true  intention  to  perform  the 
same,  as  we  shall  answer  at  tliat  great  day, 
when  the  secrets  of  all  hearts  shall  be  dis- 
closed ;  most  humbl}'  beseeching  the  Lord 
to  strengthen  us  by  the  Holy  Spuut  for 
this  end,  and  to  bless  our  desires  and  pro- 
ceedings with  such  success  as  may  be  deliver- 
ance and  safety  to  his  people,  and  encourage- 
ment to  other  Christian  Churches,  groaning 
under,  or  in  danger  of,  the  yoke  of  anti- 
christian  tyranny,  to  join  in  the  same  or  like 
association  and  covenant,  to  the  glory  of 
GOD,  the  enlargement  of  the  kingdom  of 
Jesus  Christ,  and  the  peace  and  tranquillity 
of  Christian  kingdoms  and  commonwealths. 

LECTERN,  LECTUEN.  The  reading 
desk  in  the  choir  of  ancient  churches  and 
chapels.  The  earliest  examples  remaining 
are  of  wood,  many  of  them  beautifully 
carved.  At  a  later  period  it  was  commonly 
of  brass,  often  formed  of  the  figure  of  an 
eagle  with  out-spread  wings  (See  Beading 
Desk  and  Eagle). 

The  lectern  in  English  cathedrals  gene- 
rally stands  in  the  midst  of  the  choir  facing 
westwards.  Thej'  were  formerly  more  com- 
mon in  collegiate  churches  and  chapels  than 
now,  as  ancient  ground-plans  and  engravings 
show.  In  many  places  the  fine  old  eagles  or 
carved  desks  were  thrown  into  a  comer  and 
neglected,  but  where  possible  they  have  been 
restored. 

When  the  capitular  members  read  the 
lessons  they  often  did  so  from  the  stalls. 
The  regularity  of  this  custom  may  be 
doubted ;  its  impropriety  is  evident.  It 
appears  from  Dugd.  Mon.  viii.  1257,  ed. 
1830,  that  in  Lichfield  cathedral,  all, 
v/hether  canons  or  vicars,  anciently  read 
the  collects  and  lessons,  not  from  their  own 
stalls,  but  from  the  proper  place  :  the  dean 
alone  being  permitted  to  read  from  his  stall. 
In  many  cathedrals  now,  as  at  Exeter,  the 
dean,  or  the  canon,  i-eads  the  lesson  from  the 
proper  place — the  lectern. 

LBOTIONART.  An  arrangement  of  lec- 
tions or  readings  from  the  Scriptures.    I.  In 


LECTIONAEY 

the  Jewish  Church  portions  of  the  Pentateuch 
were  read  every  Sabbath  day.  For  pohtical 
reasons  the  Pentateuch  was  prohibited  by 
Antiochus  Epiphanes,  B.C.  163,  and  the 
books  of  the  prophets  were  substituted  for 
it.  Later  on  the  Pentateuch  was  resumed, 
but  the  prophetical  books  were  also  read ; 
and  that  it  was  the  custom  to  read  both  the 
law  and  the  prophets  is  clear  from  two 
passages  in  the  New  Testament — St.  Luke 
iv.  17,  Acts  XV.  21.  The  primitive  Church 
adopted  this  practice.  Justin  Martyr  (a.d. 
J  40)  speaks  of  reading  the  writings  of  the 
prophets  as  well  as  of  the  Apostles  in 
Divine  Service  (Apol.  2),  and  the  author  of 
the  Apostolic  Constitutions  mentions  four 
lessons  as  being  read.  There  was  then 
probably  no  fixed  lectionary,  but  appropriate 
passages  were  chosen.  Although  the  an- 
tiquity of  the  Lectionary  of  St.  Jerome  is 
doubted  (see  Comes),  yet  it  appears  certain 
that  some  fixed  portions  of  the  Scriptm'e 
were  allotted  to  different  seasons  in  early 
times.  Thus  St.  Chrysostom  mentions  the 
Acts  of  the  Apostles  as  being  publicly  read 
between  Easter  and  Whitsunday ;  and  he 
also  tells  us  that  the  book  of  Genesis  was 
always  read  in. Lent  (Horn.  24  in  Bom. 
3  de  David  et  Saul).  St.  Augustine  says 
that  there  were  lessons  appropriated  to 
certain  seasons,  so  that  none  other  might 
be  read  in  their  place  (Expos,  in  1  Joan,  in 
Prm/at.),  and  he  gives  instances.  St.  Am- 
brose, St.  Cyril,  and  others  also  incidentally 
refer  to  the  fact.  So  that  it  may  well  be 
concluded  that  though  there  is  extant  no 
Lectionary  of  greater  antiquity  than  the  8th 
century  (if  we  except  the  Comes),  yet  stiU 
the  principle  of  selected  lessons  for  the 
seasons  according  to  rule  was  observed  years 
before,  and  probably  dates  from  the  time 
immediately  after  the  Apostles.  On  the 
Great  Lectionaries,  or  Synaxaria,  i.e.  tables 
of  ecclesiastical  lessons  throughout  the  year  ; 
the  Syriac  Lectionaries  or  the  Coptic  Lec- 
tionary, it  is  not  within  the  scope  of  this 
article  to  dwell,  nor  on  the  "  Menologies," 
or  calendar  of  saints'  days  (For  these  see 
Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  ii.  954). 

If.  In  the  early  English  Church  seven  or 
even  niue  lessons  were  read  at  nocturns  and 
matins.  These  were  necessarily  short,  and 
indeed  were  not  always  out  of  the  Scrip- 
tures ;  the  writings  of  the  Fathers,  and  lives 
of  the  saints  being  used.  That  tjiis  arrange- 
ment was  not  satisfactory,  may  be  seen 
from  the  Preface  to  the  Prayer  Book  "  con- 
cerning the  service  of  the  Church."  One 
great  reform  was  effected  in  the  Roman 
Lectionary  by  Cardinal  Quignonez  in  1536. 
Apocryphal  legends  were  struck  out,  together 
with  the  anthems  by  which  the  lessons  had 
been  previously  interrupted.  But  the  most 
important  change  in  the  Church  of  England 


LECTURERS 

was  wlien,  in  1542,  it  was  ordered  tliat  the 
lessons  should  be  read  in  the  vernacular 
tongue.  Great  ciire  was  taken  with  regard 
to  the  re-arrangement  of  the  Leotionary,  the 
general  rule  being  that  the  1st  lesson  for 
morning  and  evening  service  should  be  from 
the  Old  Testament,  the  2nd  lesson  from  the 
New.  The  Old  Testament  was  to  be  read 
through  once  a  year,  the  New  Testament 
twice,  with  the  exception  of  the  book  of  the 
Revelations  of  St.  John.  The  new  Leotion- 
ary was  put  furth  in  1871,  and  became 
obligatory  on  Jan.  1,  1879.  It  differs  from 
the  old  Lectionary  in  the  following  ways : 
1.  The  week-day  lessons  have  been  shortened, 
and  are  no  longer  coincident  with  the  di- 
vision of  the  Bible  into  chapters,  which  is 
often  unsatisfactor}^  2.  The  New  Testa- 
ment is  read  through  thrice  in  the  year  in- 
stead of  twice.  3.  The  second  lessons  in 
the  morning  on  ordinary  days  are  no  longer 
taken  exclusively  from  the  Gospels  and  the 
Acts  of  the  Apostles,  nor  the  second  lessons 
in  the  evening  from  the  Epistles ;  but  the 
lessons  are  so  arranged  that  when  the 
Gospels  are  read  in  the  morninz,  the  Epistles 
are  read  in  the  evening,  and  vice  versa. 
4.  The  lessons  for  festivals  and  holy-days 
have  in  some  cases  been  changed  for  passages 
more  appropriate  to  the  occasion.  5.  Alter- 
native first  lessons  are  provided  for  even- 
song on  Sundays,  when  even-song  is  said  at 
two  different  times ;  and  when  alternative 
second  lessons  are  not  provided  "  the  Second 
Lesson  at  the  second  time  may,  at  the  dis- 
cretion of  the  minister,  be  any  chapter  from 
the  four  Gospels."  6.  Certain  portions  of 
the  books  of  Chronicles,  of  Ezekiel,  and  of 
the  Apocalypse,  are  ordered  to  be  read,  and 
a  great  deal  of  the  Apocrypha  is  omitted ; 
the  lessons  from  the  latter  being  chiefly 
taken  from  "  Wisdom  "  and  "  Ecclesiasticus." 
7.  The  first  lessons  on  holy-days,  which 
were  generally  taken  from  the  Apocrypha,  ai'e 
now  chiefly  taken  from  the  canonical  books. 
However  these  changes  may  be  regarded,  it 
is  certain  that  "  the  lectionary  of  the 
Church  of  England  provides,  with  greater 
care  than  has  been  shown  by  any  other 
Christian  body,  for  the  complete  and  or- 
derly reading  of  Holy  Scripture  in  Divine 
Service." — Bishop  Barry's  P.  B. ;  Bingham, 
xiv.,  iii.  23 ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  s.v.  ;  Evan 
Daniel's  P.  B.  113 ;  Interleaved  P.  B.  (See 
Lessons).     [H.] 

LECTURERS.  These  were  persons 
whose  office  it  was  to  read  Lectures  before 
the  University.  The  name  is  given  also  to 
those  who,  receiving  either  a  settled  stipend 
or  vohmtarj'  contributions  from  the  inhabi- 
tants'of  a  parish,  were  accustomed  to  give 
a  lecture  there  under  licence  from  the 
bishop  of  the  diocese.  This  lecture  was 
in  reality  a  sermon  delivered  at  such  a  time 


LECTURERS 


441 


as  should  not  interfere  with  the  incumbent's 
ministrations.  The  lecturers  came  origin- 
ally from  the  monasteries,  but  the  custom 
of  delivering  these  lectures  continued  after 
the  dissolution  of  the  monasteries.  In 
Queen  Elizabeth's  time  Dr.  Alvey  was 
Master  of  tlie  Temple,  Mr.  T.  Travers 
was  evening  lecturer  there,  and  of  them  it 
was  commonly  said,  "  The  forenoon's  Ser- 
mons speak  Canterbury,  and  the  afternoon's 
Geneva."  The  lecturers  as  a  rule  followed 
Mr.  Travers'  example,  and  some  directions 
were  issued  to  restrain  them.  In  1C22  Arch- 
bishop Abbot  directed  that  no  lecturer 
should  preach  uiwn  Sundays  and  holy-days 
in  the  afternoon  bnt  upon  some  part  of  the 
Catechism,  or  some  text  taken  out  of  the 
Creed,  Lord's  Prayer,  or  Ten  Cummand- 
ments.  Four  years  later  the  number  of  the 
lecturers  was  largely  increased  by  twelve 
persons  being  legally  empowered  to  pur- 
chase impropriations  (q.v.),  with  tlie  pro- 
ceeds of  which  they  were  allowed  to  provide 
parishes,  where  the  clergy  were  not  quali- 
fied to  preach,  with  lecturers  to  preach 
instead  of  the  clergy.  The  trust  was  a 
dangerous  expedient,  and  was  soon  abused, 
"for,"  says  Heylin,  "  these  Lecturers  having 
no  dependence  upon  the  Bishops,  nor  taking 
the  oath  of  canonical  obedience  to  them, 
nor  subscribing  to  the  doctrines  and  estab- 
lished ceremonies,  made  it  their  work  to 
please  those  patrons,  on  whose  arbitrary 
maintenance  they  were  planted,  and  conse- 
quently to  carry  on  the  Puritan  interest 
which  their  patron  drove  at."  Moreover  in 
the  case  of  many  of  the  lecturers  their 
orders  were  doubtful,  sometimes  only  the 
so  called  orders  of  Geneva. 

That  they  caused  great  divisions  in 
parishes  appears  from  a  contemporary 
writer,  John  Selden,  "  Lecturers  do  in  a 
parish  what  the  friars  did  heretofore,  get 
away  not  only  the  afl'ections  but  the  bounty 
that  should  be  bestowed  upon  the  minister." 
He  further  adds,  "  Lecturers  get  a  great  deal 
of  money."  The  difficulties  thus  occasioned 
were  such  that,  in  1633,  Archbishop  Laud 
procured  a  bill,  exhibited  in  the  Court  of 
Exchequer  by  the  Attorney-General,  against 
the  twelve  persons  who  purchased  the 
impropriations,  charging  them  with  mis- 
applyiug  their  trust  by  appointing  lecturers 
where  none  were  needed,  and  by  appointing 
l)ersons  to  lectureships  who  did  not  con- 
form to  the  Church  of  England.  On  these 
charges  being  proven  the  Court  condemned 
the  proceedings  of  the  twelve  persons,  pro- 
nounced the  gifts  illegal,  and  confiscated 
the  money  to  the  king's  use. 

In  some  of  the  dioceses  the  lecturers 
retained  their  posts  and  occasioned  consider- 
able difficulties,  sometimes  evading  the  law 
by  calling   themselves  chaplains   (q.v.)   to 


442 


LECTURES 


some  great  house,  sometimes  founding  "  a 
running  lecture,"  i.e.  going  from  parish  to 
parish  preaching  when  and  as  they  liked. 
Many  of  the  bishops  used  great  efforts  to 
check  these  disorders.  In  1637  Archbishop 
Laud  obtained  instructions  from  King 
Charles  L  to  forbid  the  preaching  of  any 
lecturer  -who  refused  to  say  the  ofBce  from 
the  (  ommon  Prayer  in  surplice  and  hood 
before  he  delivered  his  lecture.  Archbishop 
Laud  likemse  ordered  that  the  lecture 
should  be  given  in  the  morning  that  the 
practice  of  afternoon  catechizing  should  not 
be  hindered.  Controlled  by  these  regula- 
tions the  lecturers  either  conformed,  or 
returned  to  the  trades  to  which  for  the  most 
part  they  had  been  bred,  or  else  betook  them- 
selves to  Holland.  There  they  and  their 
followers  having  lost  the  principle  of  unity 
split  into  sects  and  into  congregations,  until, 
finding  the  countiy  too  narrow  for  them, 
they  went  to  New  England,  where  they  esta- 
blished a  discipline  far  harsher  and  more 
searching  than  even  their  utmost  complaints 
had  depicted  the  discipline  of  Laud  or  Wren. 
In  1641-9,  a  portion  of  the  confiscated  reve- 
nues of  the  bishops  and  clergy  was  em- 
ployed in  providing  lecturers  for  the  parishes 
from  which,  on  one  pretext  or  another,  the 
incumbent  had  been  ejected.  At  first  these 
were  clergy  who  had  submitted  to  the 
parliament,  though  these  were  very  few,  or 
Presbyterian  ministers,  officers  of  the  army, 
and  tradesmen  of  various  sorts ;  as  years 
went  on  and  the  appetite  for  novelty  and 
excitement  increased,  Independents,  "fifth 
monarchy  men,"  ranters,  any  one  who 
claimed  to  have  "  a  gift,"  would  occupy  the 
pulpit  and  deliver  a  lecture.  During  the 
critical  period  between  the  Restoration  (May 
29,  1660)  and  the  passing  of  the  Act  of  Uni- 
formity (1662)  the  lecturers  strove  to  retain 
the  posts  they  had  acquired,  but  the  provi- 
sions of  the  Act  which  required  Episcopal 
Ordination,  the  regular  use  of  the  Prayer 
Book,  an  unfeigned  assent  and  consent  to 
all  therein  contained,  the  renunciation  of  the 
Covenant,  a  declaration  of  the  unlawfulness 
of  taking  up  arms  against  the  king,  from 
all  who  claimed-  to  minister  in  the  Church 
of  England,  compelled  most  of  them  to  leave 
the  parsonage  houses.  Some  still  continued 
irregular  ministrations,  but  the  title  of 
lecturers  seems  to  have  been  dropped  in 
connexion  with  them.  There  are  lecture- 
ships now  in  connexion  with  some  of  the 
cathedrals,  and  with  some  parishes  which  are 
relics  of  the  old  system  :  these  are  generally 
afternoon  preachers.  There  are  also  lecture- 
ships formded  by  private  individuals.  The 
foundation  of  a  lecture  gives  no  legal  right 
to  preach  it  without  the  permission  of  the 
incumbent  of  the  church,  who  has  sometimes 
refused  it.     [L.  P.] 


LEGATE 

LECTURES  (See  Bampton,  Boyle,  Don- 
nellan,  Eulsean,  Uoyer,  a.\iAWarburton). 

LEGATE  (Lat.  lego,  legatus).  A  person 
sent  or  deputed  by  another  to  act  in  his  stead. 
A  legate  is  an  ambassador,  but  the  term  has 
become  confined  to  those  who  are  deputed 
by  the  pope.    Of  these  there  are  three  kinds. 

1.  Legati  a  latere,  cardinals  sent  from 
the  side  or  immediate  presence,  and  invested 
with  most  of  the  functions  of  the  Roman 
pontiff  himself.  They  can  absolve  the  ex- 
communicated, call  synods,  grant  dispensa- 
tions in  cases  reserved  to  the  pope,  fill  up 
vacant  dignities  or  benefices,  and  hear 
ordinary  appeals.  Otho  and  Othobon,  sent 
into  England  by  Gregory  IX.  and  Clement, 
IV.  in  the  reign  of  Henry  III.,  were  of  this 
order.  The  legatine  constitutions,  or  ec- 
clesiastical laws  enacted  in  national  synods 
convened  by  these  cardinals,  may  be  seen 
in  Johnson's  collections.  Cardinal  Wolsey 
was  also  a  legate  a  latere,  and  the  bulls  of 
Leo  X.  and  Adrian  VI.,  investing  him  with 
that  high  function,  are  printed  by  Rymer,. 
from  which  we  learn  that  he  was  empowered 
to  visit  the  monasteries  and  the  whole 
clergy  of  England,  as  well  as  to  dispense- 
with  the  laws  of  the  Church  for  a  year. 
Cardinal  Pole  -was  also  legatus  a  latere. 

2.  Legati  nati  are  such  as  hold  the 
legatine  commission  ex  officio,  by  virtue  of 
office,  and  till  the  latter  part  of  the  tenth 
century  they  were  the  legates  usually  em- 
ployed by  the  papal  power.  Before  the 
Reformation,  the  archbishop  of  Canterbury 
was  the  legatus  natus  of  England.  It  is  a 
relic  of  the  legatine  authority  which  en- 
ables the  primate  of  all  England  to  confer 
degrees  independently  of  the  universities ; 
and  "  special  licenses "  for  marriage  in  any 
place  or  time  of  day,  in  both  provinces ;  and 
dispensations  for  holding  pluralities  -within 
the  limits  fixed  by  Acts  of  Parliament. 

3.  Legati  missi,  legates  given,  or  special  le- 
gates, hold  authority  from  the  pope  by  special 
commission,  and  are,  pro  tempore,  superior 
to  the  other  two  orders.  They  began  to  be 
employed  after  the  tenth  century.  They 
held  councils,  promulgated  canons,  deposed 
bishops,  and  issued  interdicts  at  their  dis- 
cretion. Simple  deacons  are  frequently 
invested  with  this  office,  which  at  once  places- 
them  above  bishops.- — Van  Espen,  pars  i. 
tit.  xxi. 

It  may  be  added,  that  the  functions  of  a 
legate  do  not  commence  till  he  is  forty  miles 
distant  from  Rome.  The  first  legate  sent, 
into  England  was  John,  precentor  of  St. 
Paul's,  and  abbot  of  the  monastery  of 
St.  Martin.  He  was  deputed  by  Agatho, 
bishop  of  Rome,  to  Theodore,  archbishop  of 
Canterbury,  in  679.  The  first  legate  in 
I  Ireland  was  Gille,  or  GiUebert,  bishop  of 
I  Limerick    early    in    the  twelfth  century. 


LEGEND 

The  Roman  cliants  were  introduced  by  him 
into  Britain. 

It  was  one  of  the  ecclesiastical  privileges 
of  England,  from  the  Norman  Conquest, 
that  no  foreign  legate  should  be  obtruded 
upon  the  English,  unless  the  king  should 
desire  it,  upon  some  extraordinary  emer- 
gency, as  when  a  case  was  too  difiicult  for 
the  English  prelates  to  determine.  Hence, 
in  the  reign  of  Henry  II.,  when  Cardinal 
Vivian,  who  was  sent  legate  into  Scotland, 
Ireland,  and  Norway,  arrived  in  England 
on  his  journey  thither,  the  king  sent  the 
bishops  of  "Winchester  and  Ely  to  ask  him 
by  whose  authority  he  ventured  into  the 
kingdom  without  his  leave :  nor  was  he 
suffered  to  proceed  till  he  had  given  an  oath 
not  to  stretch  his  commission  beyond  the 
royal  pleasure  in  any  particular. 

LEGEND,  .  LEGENDA.  In  the  first 
instance  the  word  implied  whatever  was 
appointed  to  be  read  during  public  worship 
(See  Lectionary).  It  soon  became  the 
practice,  beside  the  Scriptures,  to  read  the 
acts  of  the  martyrs  and  confessors  on  the 
days  on  which  they  were  individually  com- 
memorated, and  collections  were  made  of 
accounts  of  the  martyrs,  from  the  time  of 
Clement  of  Home.  St.  Cyprian  {Ep.  37 
ad  Glerwm)  and  Eusebius  {Hist.  v.  4)  and 
others  refer  to  these  "  Acts  of  the  Saints 
and  Martyrs  ;"  and  in  St.  Augustine's  time 
the  practice  was  general  of  reading  them  in 
the  church.  The  third  Council  of  Carthage 
(Can.  47)  orders  "tit printer  scripturas  cano- 
nicas  nihil  in  ecclesia  legatur,"  and  a  list  is 
given  of  the  Canonical  Scriptures  (which 
includes  Tobit  and  Judith),  but  it  is  added 
"  liceat  legi  passiones  martyrum,  cum  anni- 
versdrii  dies  eorum  celebrantur  "  (See  Did. 
Christ.  Antiq.  ii.  971).  Hence  the  lives  of 
saints  and  martyrs  came  to  he  called  legends, 
because  chapters  were  to  be  read  out  of  them 
at  matins,  and  m  the  refectories  of  the  re- 
ligions houses.  Many  martyrologies  exist. 
These  were  ancient  collections  of  accoimts 
of  saints  and  martyrs  (see  Martyrology), 
but  in  the  middle  ages  a  vast  number 
of  legends  of  most  extraordinary  and  ex- 
travagant character  were  added.  In  the 
Koman  Church  many  of  these  were  appointed 
to  be  read  on  saints'  days ;  which  are  as 
numerous  as  the  days  in  the  year.  How- 
ever, there  have  been  considerable  reforma- 
tions made  in  this  matter,  several  legends 
having  been  from  time  to  time  retrenched, 
insomuch  that  the  service  of  the  Church  of 
Eome  is  much  freer  from  these  than  formerly. 
The  compilers  of  the  first  Prayer  Book  of 
Edward  VI.  did  away  with  the  reading  of 
any  martyrologies  or  such-like  in  Divine 
Service,  for  they  said  by  the  "  planting  in 
of  uncertain  stories,  legends,"  &c.,  the  Bible 
was  not  properly  and  duly  read. 


LENT 


443; 


II.  Beside  these  written  legends,  there 
are  others  which  may  be  called  traditionary; 
by  which  we  mean  those  idle  stories  which 
are  delivered  by  word  of  mouth,  and  wit'n 
which  every  traveller  is  entertained  in  his 
passage  through  countries,  in  which  the 
Church  of  Home  is  predominant.  It  is 
unnecessary  to  give  instances. 

III.  The  inscriptions  cast  round  bells, be- 
yond the  name  of  the  founder  and  the  date,- 
are  called  legends.     [H.] 

LEGION,  THUNDERING.  In  the  wars^ 
of  the  Romans,  under  the  emperor  Marcus 
Antoninus,  with  the  Marcomanni,  the 
Romnn  troops  being  surrounded  by  the 
enemy,  and  in  great  distress  from  intense 
thirst,  in  the  midst  of  a  burning  desert,  a 
legion  of  Christians,  who  served  in  the 
army,  imploring  the  merciful  interposition 
of  Christ,  suddenly  a  storm  with  thunder 
and  lightning  came  on,  which  refreshed  the 
fainting  Romans  with  its  seasonable  raiOv 
while  the  lightning  fell  among  the  enemy,, 
and  destroyed  many  of  them.  The  Chris- 
tian legion  to  whose  prayers  this  miraculous 
interposition  was  granted,  was  (according  to 
the  common  account)  thenceforth  called  Tlie- 
Thundering  Legion. 

LEIEE  (Probably  a  corraption  of  the 
old  French  lieure,  for  livre,  a  hook).  A 
Service  Book.  "  Two  great  leires,  garnished 
with  stones,  and  two  lesser  leires,  garnishei 
with  stones  and  pearls,"  are  mentioned 
among  the  furniture  of  the  communion 
table  of  the  Royal  Chapel,  1565,  in  Leland's 
CoUectania,  vol.  ii.  pp.  691,  692, 1770. 

LENT.  Anglo-Sax.  lencten,  spring : 
Dutch,  lente ;  akin  to  German  lenz.  In 
the  East  called  the  Fast ;  it  is  the  Greek 
Tea-a-apaKooTT),  the  Latin  quadragesima  (40' 
days)  corrupted  in  French  to  careme. 

I.  The  holy  seasons  appointed  by  the 
Church  will  generally  be  found  to  date  their 
rise  from  some  circumstance  in  the  life  of 
our  Lord,  some  event  in  Scripture  history, 
or  a  desire  to  prepare  for  a  fitting  partici- 
pation in  the  great  Festivals.  The  origin  of 
the  season  of  Lent  is  not,  so  obvious,  though. 
TertuUian,  SS.  Epiphanius,  Augustine, 
Jerome,  and  others  claim  for  it  apostolical 
authority,  in  conformity  with  the  fasts  of 
Moses,  Elias,  and  our  Lord.  It  is  most 
probable  that  the  Christian  Lent  originated 
from  a  regard  to  those  words  of  the 
Redeemer,  "the  days  will  come  when  the 
bridegroom  shall  be  taken  away  from  them, 
and  then  shall  they  fast  in  those  days." 
We  learn  from  the  history  of  the  Church 
that  the  primitive  Christians  considered 
that  in  this  passage  Christ  has  alluded  to 
the  institution  of  a  particular  season  of 
fasting  and  prayer  in  his  future  Church. 
Accordingly  they,  in  the  first  instance,, 
began  this  solemn  period  on  the  afternooa 


444 


LENT 


of  the  day  on  whicli  they  commemorated 
the  crucifixion,  and  continued  it  until  the 
morning  of  that  of  tlie  resurrection.  The 
whole  interval  would  thus  be  only  about  forty 
hours.  Irenjeus,  referring  to  the  differences 
of  opinion  with  regard  to  the  celebration  of 
Easter,  says  that  it  is  "  not  about  the  day 
alone,  but  the  manner  of  fasting:  for  some 
thiuli  they  are  to  fast  one  day,  some  two, 
some  more ;  some  measure  their  day  as 
forty  hours  of  the  day  and  night "  (Iren.  ap. 
Eus.  H.  E.  V.  c.  24).  But  by  degrees  this 
institution  suffered  a  considerable  change, 
different  however  at  different  times  and 
jilaces.  Prom  the  forty  hours,  or  the  two 
days,  originally  observed,  it  was  extended 
to  other  additional  days,  but  with  great 
variety  in  their  number,  according  to  the 
judgment  of  the  various  Churches.  Some 
fasted  three  days  in  the  week  before  Easter, 
■some  four  and  others  six.  A  little  after, 
some  extended  the  fast  to  tliree  weeks,  and 
others  to  six,  and  other  churches  appointed 
certaiQ  portions  of  seven  weeks  in  succession. 
Thus  Sozomen  speaks  of  a  fast  of  six  weeks' 
duration  {H.  K.  vii.  19):  and  Socrates 
says : — "  The  Romans  fast  three  weeks 
before  Easter,  the  Sabbath  and  Lord's  day 
excepted.  All  Greece  and  the  Alexandrians 
fast  six  weeks.  Others  begin  their  fast 
seven  weeks  before  Easter;  only  fasting, 
however,  fifteen  days  by  intervals ;  but 
they  also  call  this  the  quadragesunal  fast " 
(JJ".  E.  V.  22).  The  result  of  all  this  was 
the  eventual  fixing  of  the  time  at  forty 
days  commencing  on  the  Wednesday  in 
the  seventh  week  before  Easter,  and 
excluding  the  intermediate  Sundays.  Ori- 
gen  (Ho:u.  x.  in  Levit.)  speaks  of  a  fast 
of  forty  days  before  Easter,  and  in  the 
4th  century  that  period  seems  to  have 
been  commonly  observed.  Gregory  the  Great, 
however,  speaks  of  the  fast  as  of  thirty- 
six  days'  duration,  i.e.  of  six  weeks,  deducting 
the  six  Sundays  {Bom,,  in  Evang.  i.  16,  5). 
In  the  East  the  Sabbath  or  Saturday  was 
also  deducted,  and  as  seven  weeks  were 
there  observed,  the  actual  days  of  fasting 
would  be  the  same — thirty-six  daj's.  It 
would  seem  that  although  Gregory  has  been 
credited  with  the  establishment  of  the 
Lenten  observance  from  the  "  Caput  Jejunii " 
•or  Ash  Wednesday,  he  really  only  counted 
from  the  Sunday,  making  about  forty  days, 
Le.  thirty-six.  The  four  additional  days 
were  added  afterwards  (Martene,  de  Ant. 
Eccles.  Bit.  iii.  58),  not,  as  appears  from 
Amalarius,  till  the  9th  century.  In  the 
11th  century  Ash  Wednesday  was  taken  as 
the  first  day  in  Lent,  thus  adding  four  days 
to  make  up  the  forty ;  but  even  now  the  rite 
of  Milan  commences  Lent  on  the  Sunday 
following.  Lent  was  first  commanded  to  be 
observed   in   this   country  by    Ercombert, 


LENT 

seventh  kug  of  Kent  (a.d.  640-690),  a^nd 
strict  rules  were  laid  down  with  regard  to 
eating  meat  &c.  during  the  season.  From 
those  early  times  to  the  present  day  Lent 
has  always  been  observed  Irom  the  first  daj", 
Ash  AVednesday,  to  Easter.  The  Sundays 
arc  excluded,  because  the  Lord's  day  is 
always  held  as  a  festival,  and  never  as  a 
fast.  These  six  Sundays  are,  therefore, 
called  Sundays  in  Lent,  not  Sundays  of 
Lent.  They  are  in  the  midst  of  it,  but  do 
not  form  part  of  it.  On  them  we  continue, 
without  interruption,  to  celebrate  our 
Saviour's  resurrection. 

II.  The  principal  days  of  Lent  are,  the 
first  day.  Holy  Week,  and  particularly  the 
Thursday  and  Friday  in  that  week.  The 
first  day  of  Lent  was  formerly  called  the 
liead  of  the  fast  ("  Caput  Jejunii  "),  and  also 
by  the  name  which  the  Church  retains — 
Ash  Wednesday.  In  the  Church  of  England 
there  is  a  solemn  service  appointed  for  Ash 
Wednesday,  under  the  title  of  a  "  Commina- 
tion,  or  denouncing  of  God's  Anger  and 
Judgments  agaiust  Sinners."  (See  Ash  Wed- 
nesday.') This  was  designed  to  occupy,  as 
far  as  could  be,  the  place  of  the  ancient 
penitential  discipline,  as  is  sufficiently  de- 
clared in  the  beginning  of  the  office  in  the 
Enghsh  Prayer  Book.  The  last  week  of 
Lent,  called  Holy  Week,  has  always  been 
considered  as  its  most  solemn  season.  It  is 
so  styled  from  the  increase  of  devotional 
exercises  among  believers.  It  is  also  called 
the  Great  Week,  from  the  important  trans- 
actions which  are  then  commemorated  ;  and 
generally  now  it  is  called  Passion  Week, 
though  Passion  Sunday  is  the  5th  Sunday 
in  Lent  (See  Holy  Week,  Passion  Sunday). 
The  Thursday  in  Holy  Week  is  that  day  on 
which  we  celebrate  the  institution  of  the 
Lord's  supper.  The  Epistle  for  the  day 
has  been  selected  by  the  Church  with  a 
view  to  this  fact.  On  the  following  day  we 
commemorate  the  sufferings,  and  particularlj' 
the  death,  of  our  Saviour  Christ.  And, 
from  the  mighty  and  blessed  effects  of  these, 
in  the  redemption  of  man,  the  day  is  appro- 
priately called  Good  Friday.  As  this  day 
has  been  kept  holy  by  the  Church  from  the 
earliest  times,  so  has  it  also  been  made  a 
time  of  the  strictest  devotion  and  humilia- 
tion (See  Good  Friday). 

III.  The  general  design  of  this  institu- 
tion is  thus  set  forth  by  St.  Chrysostom : 
"  Why  do  we  fast  these  forty  days  ?  Many 
heretofore  were  used  to  come  to  the  com- 
munion indevoutly,  and  inconsiderately,  es- 
pecially at  this  time,  when  Christ  first  j;ave 
it  to  his  disciples.  Therefore  our  fore- 
fathers, considering  the  mischiefs  arising 
li'om  such  careless  approaches,  meeting  to- 
gether, appointed  forty  days  for  fasting  and 
prayer,   and  hearing  of  sermons,  and  for 


LENT 

holy  assemblies ;  that  all  men  in  these  days 
being  carefully  purified  by  prayer  and  alms- 
deeds,  and  fasting,  and  watching,  and  tears, 
and  confession  of  sins,  and  other  the  like 
exercises,  might  come,  according  to  their 
capacity,  with  a  pure  conscience,  to  the 
holy  table"  (Bom.  in  Vet.  Test,  "in  eos 
qui  Pascha j'ejunent"). 

But  if  we  inquire  more  particularly  into 
the  reasons  of  instituting  the  Lent  fast, 
wc  shall  find  them  to  be  these  following : 
First,  the  apostles'  sorrow  for  the  loss  of 
their  Master.  For  this  reason,  the  early 
Christians  observed  these  two  days  in  which 
our  Saviour  lay  in  the  grave,  with  the  great- 
est strictness.  Secondly,  the  declension  of 
Christian  piety  from  its  first  and  primitive 
fervour.  Thirdly,  that  the  catechumens 
might  prepare  themselves  for  baptism,  and 
the  penitents  for  absolution,  Easter  being 
one  of  the  settled  times  of  baptizing  the 
catechumens,  and  absolving  the  penitents. 
And  lastly,  that  all  may  fit  and  prepare 
themselves,  as  much  as  in  them  lies,  for  a 
proper  participation  in  the  glorious  feast  of 
Easter. 

This  solemn  season  of  fasting  was  uni- 
versallj'  observed  by  all  Christians,  though 
with  a  great  liberty,  and  a  just  allowance 
for  men's  infirmities;  and  this  was  in  a 
great  measure  left  to  their  own  discretion. 
If  men  were  in  health,  and  able  to  bear 
it,  the  rule  and  custom  was  for  them  to 
observe  it.  On  the  other  hand,  bodily  in- 
firmity and  weakness  were  alwaj's  admitted 
as  a  just  apology  for  their  non-observance 
of  it. 

IV.  The  manner  of  observing  Lent,  among 
those  who  were  piously  disposed  to  observe 
it,  was  to  abstain  from  all  food  till  evening. 
Whence  it  is  natural  to  conclude,  that  the 
pretence  of  keeping  Lent  only  by  a  change 
of  diet  from  flesh  to  fish,  is  not  a  real  fast, 
but  an  innovation  utterly  unknown  to  the 
ancients,  whose  Lent  fast  was  a  strict  and 
rigorous  abstinence  from  all  food  till  the 
evening.  Their  refreshment  was  only  a 
supper,  and  then  it  was  indifferent  whether 
it  was  flesh,  or  any  other  fiKid,  provided  it 
was  used  with  sobriety  and  moderation. 
But  there  was  no  general  rule  about  this 
matter  (See  Fasting). 

V.  Lent  was  thought  the  proper  season  for 
exercising  more  abundantly  all  sorts  of 
charity.  Thus  what  persons  spared  from  their 
own  bodies,  by  abridging  them  of  a  meal, 
was  usually  given  to  the  poor.  They  like- 
wise employed  their  vacant  hours  in  visit- 
ing the  sick  and  poor,  in  entertaining 
strangers,  and  reconciling  differences.  The 
imperial  laws  forbade  all  prosecution  of  men 
in  criminal  actions,  which  might  bring  them 
to  corporal  punishment  and  torture,  during 
this  whole  season.    Lent  was  a  time  of 


LESSONS 


445. 


more  than  ordinary  strictness  and  devotion, 
and  therefore,  in  many  of  the  great  churches, 
they  had  religious  assemblies  for  jirayer  and 
preaching  every  day.  They  had  also  fre- 
quent communions  at  this  time,  at  least  on 
every  Sabbath  and  Lord's  day.  All  public 
games  and  stage-plays  were  prohibited  at 
this  season ;  as  also  the  celebration  of  all 
festivals,  birthdays,  and  marriages,  as  un- 
suitable to  the  present  occasion.  The  Church 
of  England  lays  down  no  laws,  but  the' 
principle  which  actuated  men  of  old  is  the 
same  now  as  then  (J.  Taylor,  vol.  xiv.  pp. 
31,  seq. :  Bingham,  bk.  xxi.  c.  1 :  J.  Daille  de 
Jejuniis  et  Quadra,  lib.  iv. :  Bluut's  Did. 
Theol.:  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.,  s.  v.). 

The  Christians  of  the  Greek  Church 
observe  four  Lents.  The  first  commences; 
on  the  fifteenth  of  November,  or  forty  days 
before  Christmas.  The  second  is  our  Lent, 
which  unmediately  precedes  Easter.  The 
third  begins  the  week  after  Whit-Sunday, 
and  continues  till  the  festival  of  St.  Peter 
and  St.  Paul.  The  number  of  days  there- 
fore comprised  in  the  Lent  is  not  settled  and 
determined,  but  they  are  more  or  less,  accord- 
ing as  Whit-Sunday  falls  sooner  or  later. 
Their  fourth  Lent  commences  the  first  of 
August,  and  lasts  no  longer  than  till  the 
fifteenth.  These  Lents  are  observed  with 
great  strictness  and  austerity.  On  Saturdays 
and  Sundays  they  indulge  themselves  in 
drinking  wine  and  using  od,  which  are  pro- 
hibited on  other  days.    [H.] 

LEONARD,  ST. ;  Deacon  and  Confessor  :. 
commemorated  in  the  English  Calendar  Nov. 
6.  He  was  a  nobleman  in  the  Court  of  Clovis, 
but  being  converted  by  St.  Remigius, 
he  embraced  the  religious  life,  and  retired, 
after  spending  some  time  in  a  monastery 
near  Orleans,  to  a  desert  place  on  the  right 
bank  of  the  Sarthe,  where  he  built  a  cell. 
The  place  is  still  known  by  the  name  St. 
Leonard  -  des  -  Bois  (Leonardus  -de  -  Boscis). 
There  people  flocked  to  him,  and  eventually 
a  monastery  was  built  on  the  spot  over  which 
he  presided.  He  took  a  great  interest  in 
prisoners  ;  and  Clovis  is  said  to  have  allowed 
him  to  release  such  as  he  deemed  worthy. 
Hence  he  became  the  patron  of  prisoners^ 
and  is  represented  as  a  deacon  or  a  Benedic- 
tine Abbot,  with  chains  in  his  hands,  or  a 
chained  prisoner  near.  He  died  about  a.d. 
570.— Did.  Christ.  Blog.  vol.  iii.  686.    [H.] 

LESSONS,  I.  among  ecclesiastical  writers, 
are  portions  of  the  Holy  Scriptures  read 
in  churches  in  Divine  service.  In  the 
ancient  Church,  reading  the  Scriptures  was 
one  part  of  the  service  of  the  catechumens, 
at  which  all  persons  were  allowed  to  be- 
present  in  order  to  obtain  instruction. 

The  lessons  in  the  unreformed  offices  were^ 
in  general  very  short.  Nine  lessons  were- 
appointed  to  be  read  at  matins  on  Sundays,. 


44G 


LESSONS 


and  three  on  every  week-day,  besides  a 
chapter,  or  capitular,  at  each  of  the  six  daily 
services.  But  of  the  nine  Sunday^  lessons, 
only  three  were  from  Scripture,  the  six  others 
being  extracts  from  homilies  or  martyrolo- 
gies.  At  matins  only  was  there  anything  like 
A  continuous  lesson  read.  The  capitula  or 
lectioner  verses  at  the  other  services  were 
each  nothing  more  than  one  verse  (very 
rarely  two  short  verses)  from  Scripture,  and 
these  were  seldom  varied.  As  to  the  matin 
lessons,  they  did  not  on  an  average  consist  of 
more  than  three  verses  each  :  for  though  the 
three  lessons  were  generally  in  sequence,  the 
■sense  was  interrupted  by  the  interposition 
between  each  lesson  of  a  reponsory,  versicles, 
and  the  Gloria  Patri,  so  that  edification  was 
■hereby  effectually  hindered,  as  is  remarked 
in  the  Preface  to  our  Common  Prayer, 
■"  Concerning  the  Service  of  the  Church." 

II.  The  old  Table  of  Lessons  which  had 
lasted  from  the  first  Prayer  Book  of  1549 
till  1872  was  materially  altered  then,  both  in 
the  Common  and  the  Proper  Lessons  for 
Sundays  and  holy  days  (See  Ledionary). 
The  rubrics  attached  to  it  settled  one 
question  differently  from  what  yet  seems 
to  be  known  to  many  clergymen,  that  it  is 
optional  to  read  the  Sunday  lesson  or  the 
Proper  lesson  for  a  holy  day  when  they 
concur,  except  for  Advent,  Easter,  Whit- 
Sunday  and  Trinity,  when  the  Sunday 
lessons  must  be  read.  The  Ordinary,  i.e. 
the  Bishop  in  this  case,  may  authorize  any 
■other  lessons  on  special  occasions,  and  proper 
psalms  also. 

It  has  always  been  the  understood  law  and 
pi'actice  for  laymen  to  read  the  lessons  in 
church  when  desired  by  the  incumbent  or 
the  proper  authority,  as  in  college  chapels 
where  old  usages  have  been  most  preserved, 
and  the  lessons  were  always  read  by 
scholars  or  Bible  clerks,  or  on  great  days 
by  the  Master  or  Fellows.  That  alone, 
according  to  well-known  legal  principles,  is 
an  interpretation  of  the  law,  nnless  plainly 
contrary  to  its  words.  Even  in  the  more 
important  matter  of  the  validity,  though 
not  the  propriety,  of  Lay  Baptism  (q.v.) 
old  usage  was  held  to  prevail  against  the 
apparently  plain  meaning  of  the  rubric, 
which  only  recognises  "  ministers  "as  autho- 
rized to  baptize.  But  in  the  case  of  the 
lessons  there  is  a  still  more  decisive  reason 
for  the  lawfulness  of  lay  reading,  viz.  that 
the  old  rubric  of  "  the  minister  that  readeth  " 
was  changed  in  1662  into  "  he  that  readeth." 
Though  some  persons  have  doubted  it,  it  is 
no  more  really  doubtful  than  the  lawfulness 
of  laymen  chanting  the  psalms,  and  conse- 
quently of  one  reading  the  alternate  verses, 
And  the  congregation  the  others,  where  they 
are  not  chanted.  But  it  is  part  of  the  com- 
mon law  of  the  church,  that  laymen  may 


LETTEKS 

not  read  the  prayers,  or  even  the  Epistle 
and  Gospel,  which  are  expressly  ordered  to 
be  read  by  ministers ;  and  of  course  they 
may  not  preach.  The  idea  that  bishops  can 
license  ihem  to  do  these  things  in  church 
has  no  legal  foundation  whatever;  and  for 
reading  or  preaching  anywhere  else  no 
licence  is  wanted,  or  means  anything  except 
the  personal  approval  of  the  bishop.  As  a 
surplice  is  the  officiating  dress,  and  not 
merely  clerical,  and  is  worn  by  the  scholars 
who  lead  the  lessons  in  college  chapels  on 
"non-surplice  days,"  at  any  rate  at  Cam- 
bridge, as  well  as  by  choristers  generally 
wherever  things  are  done  decently  and  in 
order,  it  seems  that  lay  readers  of  the 
lessons  ought  to  wear  a  surplice,  and  they 
often  do.  It  is  said  that  Sir  Thomas  More 
used  to  do  so.    [G.] 

LETTEES  COMMENDATORY.  Letters 
of  Commendation.  Persons  going  from  one 
place  to  another,  whether  on  a  religious 
mission,  or  on  business,  would  naturally 
require  some  testimonial  as  to  their  ability 
and  honesty.  St.  Paul  writing  to  the 
Corinthians  says,  "  Need  we,  as  some  others, 
epistles  of  commendation  to  you,  or  of 
commendation  from  you?"  (2  Cor.  iii.  1) 
implying  that  m  ordinary  cases  such  would 
be  required.  ApoUos,  when  he  went  into 
Aohaia,  took  letters  to  the  disciples  there 
(Acts  xviii.  27).  The  practice  of  giving 
letters  became  universal  in  the  Church,  and 
wherever  the  missioner  or  the  traveller 
went,  if  he  had  such  letters  of  commendation 
mth  him,  he  found  help  from  his  fellow 
Christians.  Tertullian  calls  it  the  "con- 
tesseratio  hospitalitatis "  (Ue  Prsescript. 
Emr.  c.  20).  Such  letters  were  considered 
necessary,  at  all  events  with  regard  to  those 
in  holy  orders.  "Let  no  strange  bishop, 
presbyter  or  deacon,"  it  is  enjoined  in  the 
so-called  Apostolical  Canons,  "be  received 
without  letters  commendatory  "  (c.  33).  In 
the  synod  held  at  Antiooh  in  a.d.  341  it  was 
ordered  that "  no  foreigner  should  be  received 
without '  pacific '  letters ; "  and  a  distinction 
was  made  between  these  and  other  commen- 
datory letters ;  "Let  not  country  presbyters 
send  canonical  letters,  or  at  all  events  to 
neighbouring  bishops  only"  (c.  7,  8).  So 
also  in  the  Council  of  Chalcedon  it  was 
decreed  that  those  who  were  necessitous 
should  travel  with  "pacific"  ecclesiastical 
letters  only  (emtrroKais  flpriviKois) ;  for 
letters  commendatory  were  only  for  sus- 
pected persons  (8m  to  tos  a-varaTiKas 
CTTtOToXa?  iTpoa-qK€LV  Toii  ovtri  fiovois  iv 
vwo\rj\j/€t.  iTapi')(e<T6aL  irpoaisirois,  C.  xi.). 
There  seem  to  have  been  three  grades  of 
letters  commendatory, — those  called  "pa- 
cific," which  were  more  or  less  begging 
letters;  those  commending  the  holder  to 
the  favour  of  another  bishop  (o-uorariKai, 


LETTERS 

commeudatitia,  or  commend atoria),  and 
those  beseeching  admission  for  the  bearer 
to  the  full  communion  (koo/wvikoi)  (Cyril 
Alex.  Act.  Ephes.  p.  282). 

At  the  present  day  in  the  Church  of 
England  if  a  clergyman  goes  from  one 
diocese  to  another,  he  must  have  a  testi- 
monial signed  by  three  beneficed  clergymen, 
and  countersigned  by  the  bishop  of  his 
previous  diocese,  before  he  can  be  admitted 
into  any  cure.  Thus  the  old  rule  of  letters 
of  commendation  is  carried  out.  [H.] 
_  LETTEES  DIMISSOEY  (eVioroXai 
oKokvTiKai.  Literse  formatse).  Letters  given 
by  a  bishop  to  one  of  his  clerks  removing 
to  another  diocese;  or  to  a  layman  of  his 
diocese  desiring  to  be  ordained  elsewhere. 
Bishops  were  forbidden  to  ordain  any  one 
from  another  diocese  without  letters  dimis- 
sory  from  the  bishop  of  that  diocese  in 
many  councils  (Nicaen.  i.  16;  Sardic.  16,  19; 
Carthage  i.  c.  5  ;  Trullo,  &c.).  In  England, 
by  a  constitution  of  Archbishop  Reynolds, 
"  Persons  of  religion  shall  not  be  ordained 
by  any  but  their  own  bishop,  without  letters 
dimissory  of  the  said  bishop;  or  in  his 
absence  of  his  Vicar- General."  By  Canon 
34  :  "  No  person  shall  henceforth  admit  any 
person  into  sacred  orders  which  is  not  of 
his  o\vn  diocese,  except  he  be  either  of  one 
of  the  universities  of  this  realm,  or  except 
he  shall  bring  letters  dimissory  from  the 
bishop  of  whose  diocese  he  is."  By  Canon 
35,  a  bishop  or  suffragan  offending  in  this 
respect  is  to  be  suspended ;  and  those  who 
shall  be  promoted  to  holy  orders  by  other 
than  their  own  bishop  shall  be  suspended 
from  the  exercise  of  such  order  till  they 
obtain  a  dispensation.  When  a  bishop  is 
"  in  parts  remote,"  he  who  is  especially 
constituted  Vicar-G-eneral  has  power  to  grant 
letters  dimissory  (Lindwood,  26,  32;  Gibson, 
142  seq. ;  Did.  Christ.  Ant.  558).     [H.] 

LETTERS  OP  ORBRS  (See  Orders). 
The  bishop's  certificate  of  his  having  ordained 
a  clergyman,  either  priest  or  deacon.  Church- 
wardens may  demand  a  sight  of  the  letters 
of  orders  of  any  one  offering  to  assist  in  the 
church  of  which  they  are  the  guardians. 
Care  should  be  taken  by  every  incumbent 
when  engaging  a  curate  to  see  that  he  has 
his  letters  of  orders.  From  want  of  precau- 
tion on  this  point  fraudulent  persons  have 
at  times  obtruded  themselves  into  the  work 
of  the  ministry,  and  though  afterwards  they 
have  been  detected,  and  punished  by  the 
law,  yet  serious  difficulties  have  resulted 
therefrom,  as  with  regard  to  the  validity  of 
the  ministerial  offices  which  they  have 
illegally  performed. 

LEVITICUS,  a  canonical  book  of  Scrip- 
ture, being  the  third  book  of  the  Pentateuch 
of  Moses;  thus  called  because  it  contains 
principally  the  laws  and  regulations  relating 


LIBERTINES 


447 


to  the  priests,  the  Levitcs,  and  sacrifices ; 
for  which  reason  the  Hebrews  call  it  the 
priest's  law,  because  it  includes  many 
ordinances  concerning  sacrifices.  The  Jews 
term  it  likewise  Vajicra,  because  in  Hebrew 
it  begins  with  this  word,  which  signifies, 
"  and  he  called." 

LIBELLATICL  A  designation  of  one 
kind  of  the  lapsed  from  Christianity  in  times 
of  persecution.  They  are  first  mentioned 
in  the  Decian  persecution,  and  the  origin  of 
the  name  seems  to  have  been  this.  It  is 
probable  that  the  emperor  had  decreed  that 
every  one  who  was  accused  or  suspected  of 
being  a  Christian,  should  be  permitted  to 
purge  himself  before  a  magistrate,  on  which 
occasion  a  lihellus  or  certificate  was  given 
him,  that  he  had  never  been  a  Christian,  or 
that  he  had  abjured  the  name  of  Christ. 
Some  Christians,  who  were  not  so  abandoned 
as  to  forsake  the  true  faith  utterly,  were 
yet  weak  and  dishonest  enough  to  procure 
those  libelli,  or  certificates,  by  fraudulent 
compromise  ivith  the  magistrate :  thus 
avoiding,  as  they  might  hope,  the  sin  of 
apostasy,  and  at  the  same  time  escaping  the 
sufferings  and  penalties  of  convicted  Chris- 
tians. Also  those  men  often  procured 
letters  from  the  martyrs — that  is  to  say, 
persons  already  under  sentence  of  death  for 
their  religion,  or  at  least  such  as  had  endured 
some  sufi'ering,  and  were  in  prison,  and 
uncertain  with  regard  to  their  falie — to 
commend  them  to  the  consideration  and 
kindness  of  Christians,  and  urging  that 
they  should  be  received  as  brethren  worthy 
of  their  communion.  The  influence  of  such 
letters  from  men  who,  as  martyrs,  were 
almost  idolised  was  very  great,  and  many 
bishops  and  presbyters  were  ready  to  admit 
oflFenders  who  produced  such  letters.  Against 
this  levity  Cyprian,  of  Carthage,  opposed 
himself.  He  pointed  out  that  these  letters 
were  given  with  no  discrimination ;  that 
they  did  not  definitely  describe  the  persons, 
but  merely  said,  "Receive  A.B.  'cum  suis' 
with  his  friends."  Sometimes  a  martyr 
before  his  death  commissioned  a  friend  to 
give  letters  in  his  name  to  all  applicants, 
and  some  presbyters  obeyed  these  letters 
without  consulting  the  bishop,  and  so 
subverted  ecclesiastical  order.  Cyprian, 
who  afterwards  was  himself  a  martyr,  gained 
his  point.  From  his  epistles  we  gain  an 
insight  into  the  whole  controversy  (Ep.  10, 
14, 15, 22, 27, 34, 40,  &c.;  Mosheim,  de  Behus 
Christ,  pp.  490  seq. ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  981). 

LIBERTINES.  A  sect  of  Christian 
heretics,  who  called  themselves  "Spirit- 
uals." The  sect  was  originated  by  Anthony 
Pockes,  Gerhard  Ruff,  Quintin,  and  others 
in  Flanders  about  1525  ;  from  thence  they 
passed  into  France,  and  were  encouraged  by 
Margaret  the  Queen  of  Navarre,  and  other 


448 


LIGHTS 


patrons  or  sections  of  the  Reformed  Church. 
They  maintained  that  whatsoever  was  done 
by  rben,  was  done  by  the  Spirit  of  God ;  and 
from  thence  conchided  there  was  no  sin,  but 
to  those  that  thought  it  so,  because  all  came 
from  God :  they  added,  tiiat  to  live  without 
any  doubt  or  scruple,  was  to  return  to  the 
state  of  innocency,  and  allowed  their  fol- 
lowers to  call  themselves  either  Catholics  or 
Lutherans,  according  as  the  company  they 
lighted  amongst,  were. — Calvin's  Tractatus 
Theologici,  pp.  599,  seg.  "  Instructio  adversus 
fanaticam  seclam  Libertinorum  qui  se 
Spirituales  vacant." 

LIGHTS,  Ceremonial  use  of.  Although, 
according  to  the  Jewish  ritual,  lamps  were 
continually  kept  burning  in  the  temple,  and 
minute  directions  were  given  in  the  law  in 
respect  of  all  details  with  regard  to  the  oil, 
the  candlesticks,  &o.  (Ex.  xxv.  31 ;  xxxvii. 
17 ;  Lev.  xxiv.  1,  &c.),  yet  there  is  no 
evidence  that  lights  were  used  in  a  sym- 
bolical sense,  or  in  the  ceremonial  of  wor- 
ship, in  the  aix)stolic  times.  It  was,  of 
course,  impossible  in  the  days  when  the 
Christian  offices  had  to  be  performed  in 
secret,  on  account  of  persecution,  to  have 
services  with  "blazing  lights."  But  the 
Eastern  mind  seems  to  have  hankered 
after  the  outward  symbols,  and  TertuUian 
speaks  in  terms  of  reprobation  of  the  idea  of 
exposing  useless  candles  at  noonday  (Apol. 
xlvi.).  Gregory  Nazianzen  also  objects  to 
lights  so  used.  "  Let  not,"  he  says,  "  our 
dwellings  blaze  with  visible  light,  which  is 
the  custom  of  the  Greek  holy-moon,  and 
exalt  the  present  season  (Easter)  with  un- 
becoming rites,  but  with  purity  of  soul,  and 
with  lamps  that  enlighten  the  whole  body 
of  the  church ;  that  is  to  say,  with  divine 
contemplations  and  thoughts "  (^Orat.  v. 
sec.  35),  though  he  also  speaks  of  a  lighted 
taper  placed  in  hands  of  the  baptized  (Orat. 
xl.  de  Bapt.).  In  the  4th  century,  however, 
artificial  light  was  used  in  the  churches 
during  the  daytime  as  a  symbol.  The  first 
step  was  the  burning  of  lights  in  honour  of 
martyrs,  of  which  we  have  notice  in  the 
Council  of  Eliberis  in  Spain  (a.d.  305),  in 
which  it  was  decreed  that  candles  should 
not  be  lighted  in  a  cemetery  during  the  day; 
the  reason  probably  being  that  the  practice 
would  excite  the  feelings  of  the  heathens 
against  the  Christians  (Cone.  Elih.  c.  34). 
The  practice,  however,  was  continued,  and 
Vigilantius,  himself  a  Spaniard,  inveighed 
against  it.  To  him,  Jerome  made  answer, 
and  his  answer  shows  another  step  with 
regard  to  the  use  of  lights.  "Throughout 
the  churches  of  the  East,"  he  says,  "  when 
the  Gospel  is  read,  candles  are  lighted, 
although  the  sun  be  shining — not  for  the 
purpose  of  driving  away  darkness,  but  as  au 
outward  sign  of  gladness ;  that,  under  the 


LIGHTS 

type  of  an  artificial  illumination,  that  Light 
may  be  symbolized  of  which  we  read  in  the 
Psalter,  "Thy  word,  O  Lord,  is  a  lantern 
unto  my  feet,  and  a  light  unto  mine  eyes  " 
(Jerome,  Ep.  adv.  Vigilant,  iii.).  Paulinus, 
bishop  of  Nola  (a.d.  351-431),  upheld  the 
practice  in  his  Poemata,  of  which  the 
following  is  an  example : — 

""Nocte  dieque  micant.    Sic  non  splendore  diei 
Fulget :  et  ipsa  dies  coelesU  illustris  honore 
Plus  micat  Innumeris  lucem  geniinata  lucerDis.** 

— ^Paulin.  Hab.  iii.,  St.  Felicis.) 

From  this  time  lights  were  universally 
used,  chiefly  in  connection  with  the  Sac- 
raments, and  the  reading  of  the  Gospel,  (i.) 
Baptismal  lights  were  probably  the  earliest 
used ;  tapers  were  placed  in  the  hands  of 
the  baptized,  if  adults ;  and  m  the  case  of 
iiifants,  in  the  hands  of  the  sponsors. 
Sometimes  the  lights  were  multiplied,  as  in 
the  case  of  the  baptism  of  Theodosius  the 
younger,  a.d.  401,  when  "  senators  and  men 
of  quality,"  &o.,  carried  lamps,  "so  that  one 
would  have  thought  that  the  stars  had 
appeared  upon  earth "  (Marcus  Gazensis 
ap.  Baron.,  torn.  v.  p.  131).  In  the 
Sacramentaries  of  Gelasius  and  Gregory, 
directions  are  given  with  regard  to  the 
holding  of  tapers  by  the  readers,  at  each 
"horn  of  the  altar."  At  the  font  the 
bishop,  when  he  blessed  the  water,  held  one 
of  the  tapers  in  it,  as  part  of  the  rite 
(Murat.  Liturg.  Rom.  Vet.  torn.  ii.  col.  143). 
(ii.)  Gospel  lights  are  mentioned  by  St. 
Jerome  (ut  supra),  and  Isidore  (a.d.  595) 
says  that  the  acolytes  of  the  Greeks  are 
called  "  ceroferarii "  by  the  Latins,  because 
they  carry  the  tapers  when  the  Gospel  is 
read  or  the  Eucharist  is  offered  (Etymolog. 
vi.).  They  are  mentioned  by  many  medias- 
val  writers,  and  it  has  been  conjectured  that 
the  custom  was  derived  from  the  Jews,  who 
had  a  lamp  burning  continually  before  the 
book  of  the  law  in  their  synagogues  (Le 
Brun,  i.  70).  (iii.)  Festival  lights  were  used 
around  the  tombs  of  martyrs  (Greg.  Diol^ 
lib.  iii.  c.  24),  and  especially  on  the  anni- 
versary of  their  deaths,  (iv.)  The  Feast  of 
the  Purification  was  observed  with  many 
lights,  so  that  it  was  called  Candlemas. 
(See  Candlemas).  "  Every  one,"  says  Alouin 
in  the  eighth  century,  "bears  on  that 
occasion  a  taper  when  he  goes  into  church  " 
(m  Eypapanti,  sec.  2),  and  the  practice  is- 
noticed  by  St.  Bernard  in  the  12th  century 
(See  Mansi,  ii.  52).  (v.)  Funeral  lights- 
tapers  being  carried  in  procession  are  men- 
tioned by  St.  Jerome  (Ep.  xxvii.),  St. 
Chrysostom  {Iio7a.  in  Eeh.  iv.),  Theodoret. 
(v.  36),  and  others.  In  modern  times- 
candles  are  burned  round  the  body  of  an 
illustrious  man  "lying  in  state,"  even  in 
such  cases  as  that  of  Victor  Hugo,  who  was- 
not  a  churchman,    (vi.)  The  Paschal  light 


LIGHTS 

was  in  the  first  instance  a  candle  or  lamp 
lichted  during  the  celebration  of  the  Eu- 
charist.    It  was  kept  burning  for  a  certain 
time,  and  in  early  writers  forms  for   the 
benediction  of  the  candle  or  lamp  are  found 
(See  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  p.  994).     In   the 
JEoman  churches   a  lamp  is   always  kept 
burning  when   the  Sacrament   is  reserved. 
((vii.)  Eucharistic  lights  were  very  generally 
■used,  but  it  is  impossible  to  say  when  the 
custom  commenced.     There  were  two  can- 
dles lighted  above  the  altar,  to  symboUze 
the  Light  of  the  world — Christ,  God  and 
Man.     To    this,    frequent    references    are 
made  in  ancient  writers.     In  England  we 
have  the  injunction  of  King  Edgar,  "Let 
there  be  always  lights  burning  when  Mass 
is  singing"  (Thorpe's  Laws  and  Inst.  ii. 
253).    After  the  Conquest  Osmond,  in  his 
consuetudinary,  ordered  the  treasurer  of  the 
cathedral    to  provide  four  candles  on  all 
Sundays — two  of  which  were  to  be  placed 
"  insui)er  altari."     So  also  by  the  Council 
of  Oxford  (a.b.  1222)  it  was  ordered  that 
two  candles,  "  duo  ad  minus  una  cum  1am- 
pade,"  should  be  burning  at  the  altar  at  the 
celebration  (Wilkins's  Condi,  i.  595),  and 
a,  constitution  of  Archbishop  Reynolds  (a.d. 
1322)  enjoins  "  let  two  candles,  or  one  at 
the  least,  be  lighted  at  the  Mass  "  (Wilkins's 
Concil.  1,  714 ;  see  also  Lindewood,  236). 
At  the  Reformation  superstitious  ceremonies 
■with  regard  to  lights  were  swept  away,  the 
clergy  receiving  orders  that   "  no  torches, 
(nor  candles,  tapers  or  images  of  was  were 
to  be  set  before  any  image  or  picture,  but 
only  two  lights  upon  the  high  altar,  before 
the  Sacrament,  which,  for  the  signification 
ithat  Christ  is  the  very  true  light  of  the 
tworld,  they  shall  suffer  to   remain  still" 
(Cardwell,    Docum.    Ann.    i.    7).      Queen 
■Elizabeth,  though  opposed  to  superstition, 
■yet  had  a  crucifix,  and  "  two  candlesticks, 
sai  two  tapers  burning  on  the  altar"  of 
■her  chapel.     And  though   objections  were 
made  both  by  the  archbishop  of  Canterbury 
■and  Bishop  Cox,  still  it  would  appear  that 
these  were  rather  directed  to  the  use  of  the 
crucifix ;  and  nothing  is  said  of  the  ille- 
gality of  candles.     For  their  use  on  the  holy 
table,  we  have  the  continuous  sanction  of 
■cathedrals,  royal  chapels,  and  colleges,  down 
to  the  time  of  the  Uebellion ;  and  it  could 
be,  and  has  been,  shown  that  the  replacing 
•these  articles  of  ecclesiastical  furniture  at 
'the    Restoration    occasionally    took    place. 
Bishop  Cosin,  for  instance,  speaking  of  the 
manner  in  which  the  communion  (not  ought 
to  he,  but)  "  is  celebrated  in  our  churches," 
says  it  "  is  after  this  manner  :  first  of  all,  it 
is  enjoined,  that  the  table  or  altar  should  be 
•spread  over  ■with  a  clean  linen  cloth  or  other 
•decent    covering;   upon    which    the    Holy 
Bible,  the  Common  Prayer  Book,  the  plate 


LITANY 


U9 


and  chalice,  are  to  be  placed ;  two  wax 
candles  are  to  be  set  upon  it."  It  is 
difficult  to  believe  that,  had  this  been  im- 
lawful  the  practice  should  have  been  so 
largely  sanctioned  by  the  heads  of  the 
Church,  especially  by  those  who  revised  the 
Prayer  Book.  But  generally  at  the  Resto- 
ration they  were  not  revived,  though  it  was 
not  till  very  recent  times  that  the  question 
of  their  utility  as  symbols  has  been  agitated. 
It  was  not  our  reformers  who  removed  them 
from  the  altar ;  we  have  already  shown  that 
they  deliberately  commanded  their  use :  it 
was  the  Puritans,  who  took  their  origin  in 
the  days  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  from  the  re- 
fugees in  Holland  and  Geneva  during  the 
persecutions  of  the  bloody  Queen  Mary. 
There  they  learned  a  less  Scriptural  ritual, 
which,  working  on  the  satui-nine  dispositions 
of  some,  led  eventually  to  the  greatest  ex- 
tremes of  fanaticism,  impiety,  and  crime. 

In  the  Hierurgia  Anglicana  there  are  a 
great  many  detailed  proofs  adduced  of  the 
use  of  lights  and  candlesticks  on  the  holy 
table  in  the  English  Church,  from  the  Re- 
formation downwards.  The  authorities  are 
all  given. 

In  the  opinion  of  many  ritualists,  there- 
fore, the  custom  of  the  Church  is  with  those 
who  use,  and  not  ■with  those  who  omit  the 
use  of,  lights,  although  custom  is  an  argu- 
ment brought  strongly  against  them.  And 
here  also  we  may  note  that  many  commen- 
tators on  the  Prayer  Book,  whose  judgment 
we  would  look  to  ■with  respect,  agree  in 
declarmg  that  it  is  the  law  and  the  custom 
of  the  Church  of  England  to  retain  the  two 
lights  on  the  altar. 

On  the  other  hand  it  is  to  be  remembered 
that  the  injunctions  of  1549  forbad  any  light 
"  upon  the  Lord's  board  at  any  time."  And 
though  these  had  not  the  authority  of  ParUa- 
ment,  the  Privy  Council  has  pronounced 
against  the  legality  of  lighted  candles  (but 
not  candlesticks)  at  or  just  above  the  Table 
when  not  hona  fide  required  for  light,  in 
Sumner  (Bp.)  v.  Wix,  3  Ad.  &  Ecc.  58  ;  Mar- 
tin V.  Maclconochie,  2  P.  C.  365 ;  and  Hebbert 
V.  Purckas,  reversing  a  decision  of  Sir  B. 
Phillimore. — Strype,  Annals  lief.  1559,  p. 
175  ;  1560,  p.  200,  fol.  ed.;  Cardwell's  Doc. 
Ann.  sv. ;  ii.  sec.  3  ;  Wheatly  on  Common 
Prayer;  NichoUs  on  Common  Prayer,  Add. 
Notes,  p.  34 ;  Proctor,  p.  201 ;  Maskell,  Mon. 
Bit.  i.  27  ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  993  ;  Blunt's 
Diet.  Tlieol.  414;  Walcot's  Sac.  Arch.  s.v. 
Candles.     [H.] 

LITANY  (Airai/fia,  litania,  and  let- 
ania).  Supplication  or  prayer ;  called  in 
Latin  also  rogation,  "  Litania  qua?  Latine 
rogatio  dicitur,  inde  et  Rogationes"  {Ordo 
Bomanus). 

I.  The  word,  derived  from  XltTO-ojxai,  or 
Xirotiai,  was  used   by  the    ancient   Greek 

2  G 


450 


LITANY 


writers    to    express    earnest    supplications, 
especially  to  the  gods  in  times  of  adverse 
fortune ;  and  in  the  same  sense  "  Litany " 
is  used  in  the  Christian  Church  for  "  a  sup- 
plication and  common  intercession  to  God, 
when  his  wrath  lies  upon  us."     Such  a  kind 
of  supplication   was   the   fifty-first   Psalm, 
which  begins  with  "  Have  mercy  upon  me," 
&c.,  and  may  be  called  David's   Litany ; 
such  was  that  Litany  of  God's  appointing 
(Joel  ii.  17),  where,  in  a  general  assembly, 
the  priests  were  to  say  with  tears,  "  Spare 
thy  people,  O  Lord,"  &c. ;   and  such  was 
that  Litany  of  our  Saviour  (St.  Luke  xxii. 
42),  which  kneeling  he  often  repeated  with 
strong    crying    and    tears    (Heb.    v.    7). 
St.  Paul  reckons  up  "  supplications  "  among 
the    kinds   of  Christian  offices,   which  he 
snjoins  shall  be  daily  used  (1  Tim  ii.  1) ; 
which  supplications  are  generally  understood 
to  be  Litanies  for  the  removal  of  some  great 
evil.     As  for  the  form  in  which  they  are 
now  made,  namely  in  short  requests  by  the 
ministers,  to  which  the  j^eople  all  answer, 
St.  Chrysostom  says  it  is  derived  from  the 
primitive  age.     In  the  apostolic   constitu- 
tions,  portions    of   which    were    probably 
written  m  the  2nd  century,  and  others  not 
later  than  the  4th  century,  a  form  of  suppli- 
cation is  found  resembling  closely  in  struc- 
ture the  Litanies  with  which  we  are  familiar. 
This  was  the  form  of  the  Christians'  p)rayers 
in  Tertullian'.s  time,  on  the  days  of  their 
appointment,  Wednesdays  and  Fridays,  by 
which  he  tells  us  they  obtained  relief  from 
drought.     Both  the  Western  and  Eastern 
Church  have  ever  since  retained  this  way  of 
praying.    Thus  in  St.  Cyprian's  time  Chris- 
tians  requested   God   for  deliverance  from 
enemies,  for  obtaining  rain,  and  for  removing 
or    moderating    his   judgments  ;    and    St. 
Ambrose  has  left  a  form  of  Litany,  which 
bears  his  name,  agreeing  in  many  things 
with  our  Litany.     For  when  miraculous 
gifts  ceased,  men  began  to  write  do^vn  many 
of  these  primitive  foiTos,  which  were  the 
original  of  our  modem  office.     The  "  Kyrie 
Eleison"  was  the  earliest  and  simplest  form 
of  Litany,  and  it  was  customary  to  repeat  it 
very  frequently,  sometimes  as  often  as  300 
times  (Mabillon,  Comm.  in  Ord.  Rom.  i.  2). 
Mamertus,   bishop  of  Vienne    (a.d.   467), 
composed  a  Litany  to  be  used  in  consequence 
of  the  great  earthquakes  which  had  terrified 
the  city.     On  the  eve  of  the  Easter  festival, 
while  Holy  Communion  was  being  celebrated, 
a  terrific  shock  was  felt,  the  people  rushed 
out  of  church,  and  the  bishop  was  left  alone 
on  his  knees   before  the  altar.     Then  he 
resolved  to  devote  the  three  days  before 
Ascension   to  rogations  or  litanies,  depre- 
cating the  divine  anger.     In  a  short  time 
negation  days   were  appointed  to  be  ob- 
served all  through  the  Western  Church  (See 


~      LITANY 

Sogation    Days).      Soon    after,    Sidonius,. 
bishop  of  Clermont  in  Auvergne,  upon  the 
Gothic   invasion,  made   use   of   the  same- 
office;    and  in  the  year  511,  the   Council 
of  Orleans   enjoined   that  Litanies  should 
be  used  at  one  certain  time  of  the  year, 
in  public   procession.      Ca>sarius,  of  Aries- 
(a.d.    501-542),    speaks   of   the    Rogation 
days  as  "  regularly  observed  by  the  Church 
throughout  the  world."     In  the  next  cen- 
tury, Gregory  the  Great,  on  the  occasioui 
of  a  fatal  pestilence  at  Rome,  out  of  all 
the  Litanies  extant,  composed  that  famous- 
sevenfold  Litany,  called  Litauia  Septiformis, 
from  the  fact  that  the  people  were  ordered 
to  go  in  procession  in  seven  distinct  classes ; 
which  has  been  a  p>attern  to  all  Western. 
Churches  ever  since ;  and  ours  comes  nearer 
to  it  than  that  in  the  present  Roman  missal,, 
wherein  later  popes  had  put  in  the  invo- 
cation of  saints,  which  our  reformers  have 
justly  expunged.     This  Litany  of  Gregorj- 
was  solemnized  on  St.  Mark's  day,  and  i& 
hence  sometimes  called  the   Great  Litany 
of  St.   Mark  (Mansi,   xii.   400).     By  the 
way  we  may  note,  that  the  use  of  Litanies 
in  procession  about  the  fields,  came  up  only 
in  the  time  of  Theodosins  in  the  East,  and 
in  the  days  of  Mamertus  of  Vienne,  and 
Honoratus  of  Marseilles,  in  the  year  460,  in. 
the  West ;  and  it  was  later  councils  which 
enjoined  the  use  of  them  in  Rogation  Week  ; 
but  the  forms  of  earnest  supplication  were- 
far  more  ancient  and  truly  primitive. 

II.  It  is  not  known  whether  Litanies  were 
used  in  the  early  British  Church  ;  but  Bede 
tells  us  that  St.  Augustine  with  liis  followers,, 
when  they  first  caught  siglit  of  Canterbury, 
formed  themselves  into  processions,  and 
chanted  the  Litany  of  St.  Gregory  mentioned; 
above :  "  We  beseech  thee,  O  Lord,  in  all 
thy  mercy,  that  thy  wrath  and  thine  anger 
may  be  removed  from  this  city,  and  from 
thy  holy  house,  for  we  have  sinned. 
Alleluia."  The  Litany  of  St.  Mark  was  also 
adopted  in  England  at  the  Council  of 
Cloveshoe,  a.d.  747.  From  an  early  date 
in  England,  Ascension  Week  was  called 
Gangwssca,  and  Rogation  days  Omig-dsegas,. 
meaning  "going"  or  procession  days  (See 
Gang-days).  In  the  eighth  century  invo- 
cations of  saints  began  to  appear  in '  the 
Litanies.  The  Litany  of  the  English  Chm-ch 
had  a  long  series  in  the  following  century, 
one  given  by  Muratori  naming  as  many  as 
two  hundred  and  two  saints.  In  1544  the 
Committee  of  Convocation  which  had  been 
appointed  two  years  before,  consisting  of 
Thaxton  Bp.  of  Salisbury,  Goodrich  Bp.  of 
Ely,  and  six  clergy  from  the  Lower  House, 
issued  "  the  Litany  in  English."  There  had 
been  an  English  Litany  in  many  of  the- 
primers  for  more  than  a  century  and  a  half;, 
two  are  transcribed  by  Mr.  Maskell  from 


LITANY 

MSS.  in  the  Bodleian  (Mon.  Sit.  Bed.  Ant/. 
m.  227,  233) ;  but  that  of  1544  differed  in 
the  omission  of  the  names  of  the  saints,  and 
in  some  additions  from  Hermann's  Consul- 
tation. It  retained  three  invocations  "  to 
St.  Mary,  Mother  of  God,"  "  to  Angels  and 
Archangels,"  "to  all  Saints  in  the  blessed 
company  of  heaven,"  to  "  pray  for  us." 
These  were  struck  out  in  1549,  when  also 
the  Litany  was  ordered  to  be  used  on 
Wednesdays  and  Fridays  before  the  Com- 
mimion.  At  first  it  was  evidently  intended 
to  be  used  as  a  separate  office.  In  1552  it 
was  ordered  also  for  Sundays,  probably 
because  the  mass  of  the  people  would  not 
otherwise  hear  it.  In  1662  it  was  ordered 
'.'  to  be  said  or  sung  after  morning  prayer," 
but  .the  new  Act  of  Uniformity  (a.d.  1872) 
allows  it  to  be  used  as  a  separate  service  iu 
the  morning  or  evening.  An  injunction  by 
Edward  VI.,  repeated  by  Elizabeth,  orders 
the  Litany  to  be  said  iu  the  midst  of  the 
church,  for  which  reason  a  faldstool  was 
generally  used  (See  Faldstool). 

The  Litany  of  our  Church  is  not  quite 
the  same  with  any  other,  but  differs  very 
little  from  those  of  the  Lutherans  in  Ger- 
many and  Denmark.  It  is  longer  than 
the  Greek,  but  shorter  than  the  Eoman, 
which  is  half  filled  up  with  the  names  of 
saints  invoked ;  whereas  we  invoke,  first,  the 
three  Persons  of  the  holy  Trinity,  separately 
and  jointly;  then,  in  a  more  particular 
manner,  our  Redeemer  and  Mediator,  "to 
whom  all  power  is  given  in  heaven  and 
earth"  (St.  Matt,  xxviii.  18).  The  Litany 
is  usually  divided  into  the  Invocations,  the 
Deprecations,  the  Obsecrations,  the  Inter- 
cessions, the  Versicles  and  Prayers.     [H.] 

In  some  choirs  the  Litany  is  sung  by 
two  ministers,  sometimes  by  a  priest  or 
deacon,  with  a  lay  vicar,  at  other  times  by 
laymen,  at  the  faldstool  m  the  centre  of  the 
choir.  The  singing  by  two  laymen  seems 
to  have  arisen  from  a  misconstruction  of 
the  ancient  rules,  which  directed  it  to  be 
sung  by  two  of  the  choir  :  but  the  choir  in- 
cluded priests  and  deacons,  and  clergy  in 
orders,  though  of  the  second  form.  This  is 
clear  from  the  15th  canon,  which  directs  the 
Litany  to  be  said  at  the  appointed  times  by 
"the  parsons,  vicars,  ministers,  or  curates, 
in  all  cathedral,  collegiate,  parish  churches 
and  chapels."  Though  at  first  sight  the 
word  "  vicars "  may  seem  to  include  lay 
vicars,  its  position  between  parsons  (or 
rectors)  and  ministers  or  curates,  proves  that 
it  does  not :  and  does  not  make  it  lawful 
for  laymen  to  take  the  clerical  parts  of  the 
Litany,  though  of  course  they  may  say  or 
sing  the  responses.  If  the  statutes  of  a  few 
cathedrals  appear  to  allow  it  they  cannot 
prevail  against  the  general  law.  It  is  true 
that  the  rubric  is  silent  as  to  who  shall 


LITURGY 


451 


say  the  Litany ;  but  it  is  equally  silent 
about  all  the  collects,  which  nobody  has 
ever  imagined  that  lay  vicars  may  say. 
And  it  is  the  common  law  of  the  Churcli 
that  prayers  may  only  be  read  by  priests  or 
deacons,  bearing  in  mind  that  the  word 
"priest"  is  often  used  in  the  rubrics  as 
manifestly  meaning  only  minister.  If  not, 
a  great  deal  of  the  service  could  not  be 
performed  at  all  by  curates,  who  are  only 
deacons.  It  has  been  decided  that  deacons 
may  perform  the  marriage  service,  as  they 
constantly  do,  though  only  priests  are 
mentioned  (See  Lord  Lyndhurst  in  B.  v. 
Millis  in  H.  L.  1843).     [G.] 

As  to  the  latter  part  of  the  Litany,  the 
rubric  added  at  the  last  review  is  confir- 
matory of  the  ancient  practice  of  the  Church, 
which  assigned  the  performance  of  this  part 
to  the  priest,  or  superior  minister.  This  is 
observed  in  many  choirs.  And  at  Oxford 
and  Cambridge,  on  those  days  when  the 
Litany  is  performed  before  the  university, 
the  vice-chancellor,  if  in  orders,  reads  the 
Lord's  Prayer,  and  the  remaining  part. 

LITERS  FORMATS  (See  Letters 
Commendatory). 

LITURGIUM  (Or.).  The  name  of  a 
book,  in  the  Greek  Church,  containing  the 
three  liturgies  of  St.  Basil,  St.  Chrysostom, 
and  that  of  the  Presanctified,  said  to  be 
composed  by  Pope  Gregory,  called  Dialogus. 

In  celebrating  these  three  liturgies,  the 
Greeks  observe  the  following  order.  The 
liturgy  of  St.  Basil,  as  appears  by  the  intro- 
duction, is  sung  over  ten  times  in  the  year ; 
namely,  on  the  eve  of  Christmas  day,  on  the 
feast  of  St.  Basil,  on  the  eve  of  the  feast  of 
Lights,  on  the  Sundays  of  Lent,  excepting 
Palm  Sunday,  on  the  Festival  of  the  Virgin, 
and  on  the  Great  Sabbath.  The  liturgy 
of  the  Presanctijied  is  repeated  every  day 
in  Lent,  the  forementioned  days  excepted. 
The  rest  of  the  year  is  appropriated  to  the 
liturgy  of  St.  Chrysostom  (See  Liturgy). 

LITURGY.  This  term,  adopted  into 
Christian  Greek  to  denote  any  sacred  office  or 
function,  became  specifically  applied  to  what 
we  call  the  Church  service,  and  still  more 
especially  to  the  great  Eucharistic  service, 
and  to  the  forms  into  which  these  acts  of  wor- 
ship were  cast.  The  Eastern  church  now 
uses  it,  with  such  descriptive  appellations  as 
"  divine  "  or  "  mystical,"  for  the  Eucharistic 
service,  which  the  Latin  church  prefers  to 
call  missa.  Among  ourselves  "liturgy"  is 
popularly  used  for  the  ordinary  prescribed 
service,  although  accurate  writers  on  the 
subject  restrict  it  to  the  service  of  Holy 
Communion.  The  history  of  liturgic  forms 
in  the  wider  sense  goes  back  to  the  Lord's 
Prayer  and  the  forms  of  baptism  and  of  the 
Eucharistic  institution,  and  to  such  germs  of 
hymnody  or  profession  of  faith  as  may  be 

2  o  2 


452 


LITURGY 


discerned  in  some  passages  of  the  apostolic 
epistles.  The  recently  discovered  portion  of 
St.  Clement's  Epistle  to  the  Corinthians  con- 
tains specimens  of  intercessory  prayer  used 
in  Church  service.  There  was  doubtless 
great  freedom  as  to  the  language  of  Eucha- 
ristic  worship,  e.g.  in  the  period  represented 
by  Justin  Martyr ;  and  yet  the  extant  liturgio 
documents  of  a  later  age,  belonging  to 
different  regions  of  ancient  Christendom, 
exhibit  such  an  agreement  in  general  order 
and  sequence  as  may  reasonably  be  traced 
back  to  apostolic  or  sub-apostolic  sanction. 
An  outline  would  then  exist,  which  various 
Churches  would  fill  in  at  discretion:  and 
hence  grew  up  the  five  types  or  families  of 
liturgies,  three  Eastern — the  West-Syrian, 
the  East-Syrian,  the  Alexandrian ;  and  two 
Western — the  Hispano-Grallic  and  the  Ro- 
man. A  brief  reference  may  be  made  to 
indications  of  liturgic  worship  which  are 
found  in  the  remains  of  antiquity.  The 
famous  letter  of  Pliny  the  younger  says  that 
the  Christians  used  to  sing  alternately  a 
hymn  to  Christ  as  God  :  Irenseus  mentions 
a  Catholic  form  of  thanksgiving;  a  some- 
what later  author  speaks  of  hymns  used  by 
the  brethren.  Tertullian  refers  to  the  rites 
of  baptism,  the  Amen  at  the  Eucharist,  the 
topics  of  prayer  for  the  emperor:  some  "acts" 
of  martyrdom  allude  to  the  mode  of  com- 
municating: Origen  quotes  short  prayers 
usual  in  the  church :  Dionysius  mentions 
the  Amen  of  the  communicant :  Cyprian 
refers  to  the  Sursum  corda,  and  FirmUian,  of 
Cfesarea  in  Cappadocia,  to  the  Eucharistic 
invocation,  apparently  to  the  recitation  of 
the  Eucharistic  institution,  and  to  the  baptis- 
mal renunciations:  Gregory  Thaumaturgus, 
of  Neoc£esarea,was  believed  to  have  appointed 
certain  forms  of  prayer :  the  mode  of 
Eucharistic  administration  at  Rome  is  at- 
tested by  Pope  Cornelius.  In  the  fourth 
century  Arnobius  describes  the  intercessory 
forms  in  use :  Constantine  "  recited  prescribed 
prayers  " :  Cyril  of  Jerusalem,  in  his  cate- 
chetical lectures,  describes  the  baptismal 
and  Eucharistic  services  of  his  own  church : 
St.  Athanasius  alludes  to  bidding  prayers, 
and  to  the  usual  response :  Julian  the  apos- 
tate, according  to  Gregory  of  Nazianzus, 
endeavoured  to  imitate  for  heathen  use  the 
Christian  forms  of  responsive  prayer,  of 
"  initiation,"  of  "  consecration."  St.  Hilary 
compiled  a  book  of  sacramental  offices.  A 
bishop  banished  under  Valens  recited,  be- 
fore leaving  his  church,  what  is  called 
"  the  evening  service ; "  and  the  Council  of 
Laodicea  prescribed  the  same  "liturgy  of 
prayers"  for  3  p.m.  and  for  the  evening. 
St.  Basil  mentions  hymns,  and  heads  of 
bidding  prayer,  and  tlie  then  varying  forms 
of  the  ordinary  doxology :  and  Gregory  of 
Nazianzus  says  that  he  composed  forms  of 


LITURGY 

prayer,  out  of  which  the  liturgy  called  by 
his  name  was  probably  developed.  Epi- 
phanius  gives  samples  of  prayer  for  bishops : 
and  Mr.  Hammond  has  "  arranged  in  their 
proper  liturgical  order  the  most  characteristic 
of  those  passages  "  of  St.  Chrysostom  which 
refer  to  the  rites  then  in  use  at  Antioch 
or  Constantinople, — remarking  at  the  same 
time  that  we  have  no  good  evidence  for  the 
statement  that  he  himself  composed  a  liturgy. 
St.  Augustine  similarly  illustrates  the  liturgic 
use  of  the  Church  of  Africa :  e.g.  he  mentions 
the  Sursum  corda,  the  deacon's  bidding 
prayer,  and  a  brief  prayer  for  the  persever- 
ance of  the  faithful,  &c.  African  councils 
ordered  that  prayer  at  the  altar  should  be 
addressed  to  the  Father,  and  that  no  bishop 
should  prescribe  any  prayers  for  his  own 
church's  use  which  had  not  been  carefully 
examined  and  approved  in  synod.  This 
was  a  judicious  restriction  of  the  "jus 
hturgicum,"  or  the  right  of  the  diocesan  over 
the  worship  of  his  church,  which  ill-informed 
prelates  might  have  abused.  The  most 
solemn  part  of  the  liturgy,  beginning  with 
the  Sursum  corda  and  including  the  conse- 
cration, is  technically  called  the  "  anaphora  " 
and  the  "  canon." 

The  existing  liturgies  called  by  the  names 
of  St.  James,  St.  Mark,  and  St.  Clement, 
have,  it  need  not  be  said,  no  right  to 
authorship  so  venerable.  The  "liturgy  of 
St.  James,"  in  the  Greek  and  Syriac  forms, 
represents  the  ancient  rite  of  West  Syria  in 
a  certain  stage  of  its  development,  the  name 
of  St.  James  indicating  its  connexion  with 
Jerusalem.  A  large  part  of  the  Greek  form 
agrees  so  well  with  the  Syriac,  that  both 
must  so  far  be  traced  to  a  period  earlier  than 
the  severance  of  the  Syrian  Christians  from 
the  orthodox  in  the  middle  of  the  fifth 
century :  much  of  it,  again,  reminds  us  of 
Cyril's  description  of  the  service  of  the 
fourth.  On  the  other  hand,  a  good  deal  is 
clearly  of  later  date,  as  is  the  case  with  other 
great  Eastern  liturgies.  The  "liturgy  of 
St.  Mark  "  is  a  form  of  the  Alexandrian  rite 
modified  under  the  influence  of  Constanti- 
nople :  the  Alexandrian  characteristics  are 
thought  to,  be  better  preserved  in  the  Coptic 
service  called  after  St.  Cyril.  The  "  Kturgy 
of  St  Clement,"  found  in  the  "  Apostohcal 
Constitutions,"  is  considered  by  some  to  be 
"  the  prototype  of  the  West  Syrian  family," 
and  "accurately  to  represent  the  general 
mode  "  of  Eucharistic  celebration  prior  to  the 
fourth  century :  others  assign  to  it  a  later  date 
and  an  inferior  value.  The  present  liturgy 
of  St  Basil  is  regarded  as  a  "derivative  from 
"  St.  James,"  and  that  of  St.  Chrysostom 
and  the  Armenian  are  similarly  called  off- 
shoots of  St.  Basil.  Of  the  East-Syrian 
liturgies,  now  used  only  by  the  Nestorian 
Christians,  the  oldest  is  that  called  after 


LITUKGY 

Acteus  and  Maris,  who  are  named  among 
the  evangehzers  of  that  region.  "  To  this 
family  also,"  says  Mr.  Hammond,  "  belonged 
the  original  liturgy  of  the  Christians  of  St. 
Thomas  on  the  Malabar  coast  of  India." 
He  uses  the  name  "  Hispano-GaUican  "  for 
the  family  which  some  call  Ephesine  and 
connect  with  St.  John;  there  being  a 
marked  affinity  between  the  GralUcaa  htm- 
gies  and  the  Mozarabic  or  old  Spanish,  and 
between  these  together  and  the  Eastern 
types.  In  fact,  the  "Hispano-Gallican  family" 
stands  between  the  Eastern  and  the  Roman. 
That  the  church  of  Lyons  was  a  daughter  of 
the  church  of  Bphesus  is  one  of  those  facts 
in  church  history  which  illustrate  the  subject 
of  liturgiology.  The  Galilean  "  use "  had 
great  variety  and  flexibility.  The  "  missals  " 
called  Gothic,  Galhc,  and  Frankish,  are 
supposed  to  represent  the  ancient  rites  of 
Southern,  Central,  and  North-Western  Gaul. 
To  these  may  be  added  a  sacramentary  or 
missal  discovered  by  MabiUon  at  Bobbio,  and 
some  other  liturgic  fragments.  The  Moz- 
arabic rite,  still  allowed  to  exist  in  a  very 
few  Spanish  churches,  is  elaborate  and  richly 
poetical.  In  South  Britain,  before  the 
mission  of  St.  Augustine  of  Canterbury,  the 
rites  used  were  doubtless  akin  to  the  Galil- 
ean ;  while  the  Irish  used  both  the  Koman 
and  the  Gallican  or  GaUioo-British  liturgies. 
The  Roman  Liturgy,  sometimes  called  after 
St.  Peter,  is  thought  to  have  in  fact  super- 
seded a  Greek  hturgy  used  in  the  earUer 
Koman  Church.  "  The  canon,"  as  we  know 
it,  must  have  existed  before  Leo  the  Great, 
probably  before  Innocent  I.,  who  mentions 
two  features  of  the  rite  of  his  own  time  : 
but  it  was  not  completed  until  the  days  of 
Gregory  the  Great.  Before  Gregory's  time, 
Gel^ius  I.  had  composed  some  Eucharistic 
prayers  and  prefaces,  and  added  them  to 
earher  compositions :  his  work  was  revised 
and  condensed  by  Gregory,  who  also  placed 
the  Lord's  Prayer  just  after  the  canon, 
instead  of  after  the  "  fraction."  The  Roman 
rite,  as  thus  settled,  was  doubtless  intro- 
duced by  Augustine  into  the  English  Church, 
probably  'with  but  scanty  use  of  Gregory's 
permission  to  adopt  at  discretion  either 
Roman  or  non-Roman  observances.  The 
Ambrosian  rite  is  substantially  akin  to  the 
Roman :  "  its  coincidences  with  the  Gallican 
are  few  and  unimportant." 

In  the  pre-Refoi-mation  period  the  English 
Church  had  several  "  uses  "  or  missals,  the 
chief  being  that  of  Sarum,  compiled  by 
Osmund,  bishop  of  Sarum  (a.d.  1078).  But 
the  canon  was  the  same  in  them  all.  The 
diversities  of  use  in  Ireland  appear  to  have 
been  removed  by  the  synod  of  KeUs  (a.d. 
1192)  when  the  Roman  rites  were  estab- 
hshed,"  and  the  use  of  Sarum  was  generally 
adopted.    [W.  B.] 


LOLLARDS 


453 


LITURGY  OP  THE  CHURCH  OF 
ENGLAND  (See  Prayer  Booh). 

LOGOS  (See  Word,  The). 

LOLLARDS.  The  derivation  of  this 
word  is  not  clear.  Some  have  imagined 
it  to  be  derived  from  "  lolium,"  darnel  or 
tares ;  but  this  was  probably  an  invention 
of  the  monks,  who  would  naturally  regard 
the  Lollards  as  weeds,  and  indeed  they  are 
referred  to  as  such  in  the  Bulls  of  Gregory 
XL  (a.d.  1377).  There  was  a  certain 
Walter  Lolhardus,  who  was  burned  for 
heresy  at  Cologne  a.d.  1332,  but  it  is  a 
question  whether  his  name  was  a  real  one, 
or  merely  a  surname  or  epithet  applied  to 
him.  It  would  seem  most  probable  that 
the  word  was  derived  from  the  German 
"loUen,"  to  sing  softly,  so  that  Walter's 
epithet  implied  merely  that  he  went  about 
singing  in  undertone  his  ideas,  and  in  fact 
was  only  one  of  those  who,  assisting  at 
funerals  and  other  offices,  used  their  position 
to  work,  as  they  thought,  reforms.  In 
England  the  term  "  Lollards  "  is  connected 
with  Wiclif,  who  was  supposed  to  be  their 
leader  (See  Widifitea).  These  Lollards, 
in  1395,  having  affixed  hbels  against  the 
clergy  in  the  most  public  places  in  the 
capital,  had  prepared  an  inflammatory  peti- 
tion to  be  presented  to  the  House  of  Com- 
mons. "This  instrument,"  says  Lingard, 
"  is  a  strange  compound  of  fanaticism  and 
foUy"  {Hist,  of  Eng.  iv.  233).  But  there 
is  no  doubt  that  the  Lollards  struck  a  blow 
against  the  evil  doings  of  the  celibate  cleigy, 
and  their  immoral  lives,  and  also  against 
transubstantiation,  and  other  superstitious 
errors.  The  Lollards  in  England  went  into 
extravagant  extremes,  but  with  regard  to 
these  Wiclif  could  not  be  called  their  leader. 
He  may  justly  be  accounted  one  of  the 
greatest  men  that  our  country  has  produced. 
He  is  one  of  the  very  few  who  have  left 
the  impress  of  their  minds,  not  only  on  their 
own  age,  but  on  all  time.  He  it  was,  who 
first,  in  the  middle  ages,  gave  to  faith  its 
subjective  character.  His  first  grand  position 
was  taken  on  the  ground  of  faith — -we  are 
not  to  accept  as  truth  what  we  do  not 
believe.  He  then  asserted,  that  we  cannot 
beheve  what  we  cannot  prove,  or  what  has 
not  been  proved  to  others  on  whose  judg- 
ment and  veracity  we  rely,  and  who  are 
ready  to  produce  their  proofs,  on  demand. 
His  next  step  was,  to  maintain  that  the 
only  proof  by  which  we  can  establish  a 
disputed  proposition  in  revealed  religion 
must  be  deduced  from  the  Bible.  The 
Bible  only  is  the  infallible  Word  of  God. 
What  the  Church  cannot  read  therein,  or 
prove  thereby,  no  man  can  be  called  uix)n  to 
believe.  Therefore  the  Bible  must  be  trans- 
lated, and  he  translated  it  (See  Bible). 
Here  was  his  principle.     In  the  application 


454 


LOMBAEDICKS 


of  it  however  lie  fell  into  many  and, great 
errors,  and  in  many  of  his  opinions  he  seems 
to  have  been  fluctuating  and  inconsistent. 
The  Lollards,  who  were  called  his  followers, 
magniBed  his  errors,  and  the  trouble  which 
Wiclif  had  to  endure  arose  less  from  his  own 
actions  or  teaching,  than  from  the  political 
strife  into  which  his  followers  brought  him. 
When  Wiclif  was  tried  before  Archbishop 
Courtenay  at  Blackfriars  a.d.  1377-82,  twenty- 
four  charges  were  brought  against  him.  Of 
these,  article  4.  was  that  a  bishop  or  priest, 
if  he  be  in  mortal  sin,  does  not  ordain,  con- 
secrate, nor  baptize  :  art.  5.  that  if  a  man 
be  contrite  all  exterior  confession  is  useless  to 
him:  art.  6.  that  there  is  no  foundation  in 
the  Gospel  for  Christ's  ordaining  the  Mass 
(but  probably  Wichf  intended  the  idea  of 
Holy  Communion  in  its  place)  :  art.  14.  that 
it  is  contrary  to  Holy  Scripture  that  ecclesias- 
tical men  should  have  temporal  possessions : 
art.  18:  that  tithes  are  pure  alms,  and  that 
the  parishioners  are  able  to  detain  them 
because  of  the  wickedness  of  their  curates, 
and  bestow  them  on  others  at  their  pleasure. 
Other  articles  were  directed  against  the 
abuses  of  the  times  (Wilkins,  Condi,  iii. 
157).  Wiclif  himself  had  one  object  in 
view,  the  reformation  of  abuses ;  though  as 
a  reformer,  as  is  generally  the  case,  he  went 
into  extremes.  The  Lollards,  however,  after 
his  death,  which  took  place  in  1384,  became 
a  turbulent  poUtical  faction,  and  measures 
were  frequently  taken  against  them.  The 
most  prominent  trial  for  LoUardism  was  that 
of  Sir  John  Oldcastle,  commonly  called  Lord 
Cobham,  who  at  first  escaped,  but  afterwards, 
leading  a  revolutionary  party,  was  condemned 
and  burnt  to  death.  He  seems  to  have 
been  a  fanatic  with  regard  to  rehgion,  but 
LoUardism  at  that  time  was  of  a  political 
rather  than  a  religious  character.  That 
some  of  the  bishops  were  inclined  to  deal 
leniently  with  ■  LoUardism  is  evidenced  by 
the  instance  of  LoUard  Towers  attached  to 
some  episcopal  palaces ;  which  seems  to 
imply  that  the  bishops  did  not  wish  to  hand 
over  the  Lollards  to  the  civil  power,  but 
imprisoned  them  in  their  domain,  at  their 
own  expense. — Milner's  Hist,  of  Church, 
cent.  xiv.  ch.  iii. ;  Holinshed,  Hen.  F.^;  Ant. 
Wood's  Antiq.  Oxon.  vol.  i.  p.  183  sej- ; 
Middleton's  Biog.  Evan.  vol.  i.  p.  1  seq. ; 
Wilkins,  ut  sup. ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim,  ii. ; 
Hook's   Archhishops,  iii.  76 :  iv.  511.     [H.] 

LOMBAEDICKS.  Flat  tombstones, 
generally  of  granite  or  alabaster,  coffin 
shaped,  with  a  slightly  raised  cross  in  the 
centre,  and  a  legend  running  round  it. 

LORD,  CUB.  LORD.  The  Lord  Jesus 
Christ  is  such  to  us,  as  He  is, 

1.  Our  Saviour. 

I  will  place  salvation  in  Zion  (Isa.  xlvi. 
13).     Behold   thy  salvation  cometh   (Isa. 


LORD 

Ixii.  11).  I  speak  in  righteousness,  miglity 
to  save  (Isa.  Ixiii.  1).  Thou  shalt  call  his 
name  Jesus,  for  he  shall  save  his  people 
from  their  sins  (St.  Matt.  i.  21).  The  Father 
sent  the  Son  to  be  the  Saviour  of 'the  world 
(1  St.  John  iv.  14).  To  be  a  Prince  and 
a  Saviour  (Acts  v.  31).  The  author  of 
eternal  salvation  (Heb.  v.  9).  God  our 
Saviour  (Tit.  ii.  10).  The  great  God,  and 
even  our  Saviour  Jesus  Christ  (Tit.  ii. 
13).  God  hath  not  appointed  us  to  wrath ; 
but  to  obtain  salvation  by  our  Lord 
Christ  Jesus  (1  Thess.  v.  9).  That  the 
world  through  him  might  be  saved  (St.  John 
iii.  17).  This  is  a  faithful  saying,  &c.,  that 
Jesus  Christ  came  into  the  world  to  save 
sinners  (1  Tim.  i.  15).  Neither  is  there 
salvation  in  ant/  other ;  for  there  is  none 
other  name  under  heaven  ,  given  among 
men,  whereby  we  must  be  saved  (Acts 
iv.  12.  See  also  St.  Matt  i.  21 ;  xviiL  11 ; 
St.Lukeii.il;  St.  John  iii.  17;  iv.  42;  xii. 
47  ;  Acts  XV.  11 ;  Rom.  v.  9 ;  x.  9  ;  Eph. 
v.  23;  Phil.  iii.  20;  1  Thess.  i.  10;  Heb.  ii. 
3  ;  vii.  25  ;  Tit.  iii.  5,  6). 

2.  Our  Sacrifice  for  sin. 

The  Spirit — testified  beforehand  the 
sufferings  of  Christ  (1  St.  Pet.  i.  11).  Be- 
hold the  Lamh  of  God,  which  taketh  away 
(beareth)  the  sin  of  the  world  (St.  John  i. 
29).  The  Lamb  slain  from  the  foundation 
of  the  world  (Rev.  xiii.  8).  Christ  our 
passover  is  sacrificed  (slain)  for  us  (1  Cor. 
V.  7).  Christ  died  for  our  sins  according 
to  the  Scriptures  (1  Cor.  xv.  3).  His  own 
self  bare  our  sins  in  his  own  body  on  the 
tree  (1  St.  Pet.  ii.  24).  And  hath  given  him- 
self for  us,  an  offering  and  u.  sacrifice  to 
God  (Eph.  V.  2).  An  offering  for  sin 
(Isa.  liii.  10).  Once  offered  to  bear  the  sins 
of  "many  (Heb.  ix.  28).  Thus  it  behoved 
Christ  to  suffer  (St.  Luke  xxiv.  46).  The 
just  for  the  unjust,  that  he  might  bring  us 
to  God  (1  St.  Pet.  iii.  18).  Hereby  perceive 
we  the  love  of  God,  because  he  laid  down 
his  life  for  us  (1  St.  John  iii.  16.  See  also 
Isa.  liii.  6 — 12  ;  Dan.  ix.  26  ;  St.  Luke  xxiv. 
26 ;  St.  John  iii.  14,  15  ;  xv.  13 ;  Acts  iii. 
18;  xxvi.  23;  Rom.  iv.  25;  2  Cor.  v.  21; 
Heb.  ix.  26 ;  X.  5  ;  1  St.  John  i.  7  ;  ii.  2). 

3.  Our  Redeemer. 

I  know  that  my  Redeemer  liveth,  and 
that  he  shall  stand  at  the  latter  day  upon 
the  earth  (Job  xix.  25).  The  redeemer 
shall  come  to  Zion  (Isa.  lix.  20).  Christ 
hath  redeemed  us  from  the  curse  of  the  law, 
being  made  a  curse  for  us  (Gal.  iii.  13). 
Redeemed  with  the  precious  blood  of  Christ 
(1  St.Pet.  i.  18, 19).  Having  obtained  efernaZ 
redemption  for  us  (Heb.  ix.  32.  See  also 
Job  x.xxiii.  23,  24;  St.  Matt.  xxvi.  28;  Eom. 
iii.  24;  1  Cor.  i.  30 ;  Eph.  i.  7;  Rev.  v.  9). 

4.  Our  Mediator. 

There  is  one  Mediator  between  God  and 


LOED 

man,  the  niau  Christ  Jesus  (1  Tim.  ii.  5). 
He  is  the  Mediator  of  a  new — ^a  better 
—covenant  (Heb.  viii.  6 ;  xii.  24).  The 
Mediator  of  the  New  Testament  (Heb.  ix. 
15).  No  man  cometh  to  the  Father  but 
hrj  rue  (St.  John  xiv.  6.  See  also  Job  ix.  2  ; 
St.  John  xvi.  23 ;  Heb.  vii.  25  :  xi.  9 ;  1  St. 
Pet.  ii.  5). 

5.  Our  Advocate. 
We  have  an  advocate  with  the  Father, 

Jesus  Christ  the  righteous  (1  St.  John  ii.  1. 
•See  also  Heb.  ix.  24). 

6.  Our  Intercessor. 
He  saw  that    there  was  no  man,  and 

■wondered  that  there  was  no  Intercessor ; 
therefore  his  arm  brought  salvation  (Isa. 
lix.  16).  He  made  intercession  for  the 
transgressors  (Isa.  liii.  12).  He  ever  liveth 
to  make  intercession  for  them  (Heb.  vii. 
25.     See  also  Rom.  viii.  34). 

7.  Our  Propitiation. 
He  is  the  propitiation  for  our  sins  :  and 

not  for  ours  only,  but  also  for  the  sins  of 
the  whole  world  (1  St.  John  ii.  2).  Whom 
God  hath  set  forth  to  be  o  propitiation, 
through  faith  in  his  blood  (Rom.  iii.  25). 

8.  Our  Ransom. 
He    is    gracious    unto    him,   and    saith, 

Dehver  him  from  going  down  to  the  pit,  I 
have  found  a  ransom  (Job  xxxiii.  24). 
The  Son  of  man  came — to  give  his  life  a 
ransom  for  many  (St.  Matt.  xx.  28).  A 
ransom  for  all  to  be  testified  in  due  time 
,(1  Tim.  ii.  6). 

9.  Our  Righteousness. 
Their  righteousness  is  of  me,  saith  the 

Lord  (Isa.  liv.  17).  Tlie  righteousness  of 
God  which  is  in  faith  by  Jesus  Christ  to 
all  (Rom.  iii.  22).  The  Lord  our  right- 
eousness (Jer.  xxiii.  6.  See  also  Isa.  Ixi. 
10  ;  Dan.  ix.  24 ;  1  St.  John  ii.  1,  29). 

10.  Our  Wisdom. 
Christ  Jesus,  who  of  God  is  made  unto 

us  wisdom  (1  Cor.  i.  17,  30.  See  also  Isa. 
ix.  6  ;  Eph.  i.  17  ;  iii.  4). 

11.  Our  Sanctification. 
Jesus  also,  that  he  might  sanctify  tJie 

people  with  his  own. blood,  suffered  with- 
out the  gate  (Heb.  xiii.  12).  We  are 
■sanctified  through  the  offering  of  the  body 
of  Jesus  Christ  (Heb.  x.  10.  See  also 
Mai.  iii.  3  ;  St.  Matt,  iii  12 ;  St.  John  xvii. 
19 ;  1  Cor.  i.  2 ;  vi.  11 ;  Eph.  v.  25,  26  ; 
Heb.  X.  14 ;  1  St.  John  i.  7). 

(Of  him  are  ye  in  Christ  Jesus,  who  of 
God  is  made  unto  us  wisdom,  and  right- 
■eousness,  and  sanctification,  1  Cor.  i.  30). 

12.  Our  Lord  and  our  God. 
St.  John  XX.  28. 

II.  As  He  is, 

1.  The  Messiah. 

Messiah  the  prince  (Dan.  ix.  25, 26).  We 
iiave  found  the  Messias,  which  is,  being  inter- 


LOED 


455 


preted,  the  Christ  (the  anointed)  (St.  John 
i.  41).  Anointed — to  preach  good  tidings 
unto  the  meek  (Isa.  Ixi.  1).  To  preach 
the  gospel  to  the  poor,  &c.  (St.  Luke  iv.  18). 

2.  The  Head  of  the  Church. 
Christ  is  the  Head  of  the  Church  (Eph. 

V.  23).  God — gave  him  to  be  the  head 
over  all  things  to  the  CJiurch,  which  is  his 
body  (Eph.  i.  22,  23.  See  also  Ps.  cxviii. 
22;  St.  Matt.  ii.  6;  xxL  42;  St.  John  x. 
14 ;  Acts  iv.  11 ;  Rom.  xii.  5 ;  1  Cor.  vi. 
15  ;  xii.  27 ;  Eph.  ii.  20 ;  iv.  12—15 ;  v. 
29;  CoL  i.  18,  24;  Heb.  iii.  1';  xiii.  20;  1 
St.  Pet.  ii.  6,  25). 

3.  The  Power  of  God. 
Unto  them  which  are  called — Christ  the 

power  of  God  (1  Cor.  i.  24).  Declared  to 
be  the  Son  of  God  with  power  (Rom.  i.  4). 
The  brightness  of  his  glory,  and  the  express 
image  of  his  person,  and  upholding  all 
things  by  the  word  of  his  power  (Heb.  i. 
3).  For  in  him  dwelleth  all  the  fullness  of 
the  Godhead  bodily  (Col.  ii.  9.  See  also 
St.  Matt.  ix.  6  ;  xi.  27 ;  xxviii.  18  ;  St.  Luke 
iv.  32  ;  Acts  xx.  32  ;  Eph.  i.  20,  21 ;  Col.  ii. 
10  ;  2  Tim.  i.  12  ;  1  St.  Pet.  iii.  22  ;  Rev.  xi. 
15). 

4.  The  Truth. 
I  am  the  truth  (St.  John  xiv.  6).     Grace 

and  truth  came  by  Jesus  Christ, — the  only 
begotten  of  the  Father,  ftdl  of  grace  and 
truth  (St.  John  i.  17,  14).  TJie  Amen,  the 
faithful  and  true  wtness  (Rev.  iii.  14. 
See  also  Isa.  xiii.  3 ;  St.  John  viii.  14,  32 ; 
xvlii.  37 ;  2  Cor.  xi.  10 ;  Eph.  iv.  21 ;  I 
St.  John  V.  20 ;  Rev.  xix.  11 ;  xxii.  6). 

5.  The  King  of  kings,  and  Lord  of  lords. 
Rev.   xvii.  14 ;   xix.  16.     And  see  also 

Ps.  Ixxxix.  27;  Dan.  vii.  14,  27;  Zech. 
xiv.  9  ;  1  Tim.  vi.  15  ;  Rev.  i.  5  ;  xi.  15. 

6.  The  Lord  of  Glory. 
1  Cor.  ii.  8  ;  St.  Jas.  ii.  1. 

7.  The  Lord  of  All. 
Jesus  Christ,   he  is   Lord  of  all   (Acts 

z.  36).  To  this  end  Christ  both  died,  and 
rose,  and  revived,  that  he  might  be  Lord 
both  of  the  dead  and  living  (Rom.  xiv. 
9).  And  that  -every  tongue  should  confess 
that  Jesus  Cbrist  is  Lord  (Phil.  ii.  11. 
See  also  Josh.  v.  14';  MioaA-.  v.  2  ;  St.  John 
xiii.  13  ;  xvi.  15  ;  Acts  ii.  36  ;  Rom.  x.  12  ; 

1  Cor.  viii.  6  ;  xii.  5 ;  xv.  47  ;  2  Thess.  i.  7; 

2  Tim-,  iv.  8  ;  Col.  iii.  24  ;  Heb.  i.  2 ;  ii.  8  ; 
xiii.  20 ;  Rev.  i.  8  ;  v.  5). 

III.  -Through  Him  we  have, 

1.  Grace  (St.  John  i.  16  ;  Acts  xv.  11 ; 
Rom.  i.  5 ;  iii.  24 ;  v.  2,  15—21 ;  xvi.  20, 
and  similar  passages.  1  Cor.  i.  4 ;  xv.  10  ; 
2  Cor.  viii.  9 ;  xii.  9 ;  Eph.  i.  7  ;  ii.  7 ;  iv. 
7  ;  vi.  24  ;  1  Tim.  i.  2,  14 ;  2  Tim.  i.  9 ;  2 
St.  Pet.  iii.  18). 

2.  Power  (1  Cor.  i.  18 ;  2  Cor.  xii.  9  ; 
Eph.  vi.  8  ;  Phil.  iv.  13 ;  Col.  i.  29 ;  1  Tim. 


45G 


LOED 


i.  12 ;   2   Tim.  i.  9,  12 ;   Heb.  ii.  14,  18 ; 
xiii.  21). 

3.  Faith  (St.  Matt.  is.  2 ;  St.  Jolm  vi.  45 ; 
Acts  xxvi.  18 ;  iii.  16  ;  Rom.  iii.  22,  25 ; 
V.  2;  1  Cor.  iii.  5;  Gal.  ii.  20;  iii.  22; 
Bph.  ii.  8  ;  PMl.  i.  29  ;  iii.  9 ;  Col.  ii.  5,  7  ; 
1  Tim.  iii.  13 ;  iv.  6 ;  1  St.  Pet.  ii.  6  ;  1  St. 
Jolin  V.  14). 

4.  Forgiveness  of  sins  (Zecli.  xiii.  1 ;  St. 
Matt.  ix.  6  ;  St.  Luke  xxiv.  47 ;  St.  John  i. 
29 ;  Acts  ii.  38 ;  v.  31 ;  x.  43 ;  xiii.  38 ;  Horn, 
viii.  1 ;  2  Cor.  ii.  10 ;  Eph.  i.  7 ;  iv.  32  ; 
Heh.  ix.  26  ;  1  St.  John  ii.  12  ;  Kev.  i.  5). 

5.  Justification  (Isa.  Uii.  11;  Acts  xiii. 
39  ;  Bom.  iii.  24,  26 ;  iv.  25 ;  v.  1,  9,  16, 
18;  viii.  1;  x.  4;  1  Cor.  vi.  11;  Gal.  ii. 
16,  21 ;  iii.  8,  11,  24 ;  Phil.  iii.  9 ;  Tit.  iii. 

7)- 

6.  Patience  (Ps.  xxxvii.  7,  with  2  Thess. 

iii.  5 ;  1  Thess.  i.  3 ;  2  Thess.  i.  4;  2  Tim. 
ii.  24  ;  Heb.  vi.  12  ;  x.  36  ;  xii.  1 ;  St.  James 
V.  7,  8;  Eev.  i.  9;  ii.  2,  3,  19 ;  iii.  10;  xiv. 
12). 

7.  Light  (Isa.  xlix.  6 ;  St.  Luke  ii.  32  ; 
St.  John  i.  9  ;  iii.  19  ;  viii.  12  ;  ix.  5  ;  xii.  35, 
36, 46 ;  2  Cor.  iv.  4,  6 ;  Eph.  v.  14 ;  1  St:  John 
ii.  8 ;  Eev.  xxi.  23). 

8.  Life  (St.  John  i.  4  ;  iii.  36 ;  v.  21,  24 ; 
vi.  27,  33,  40 ;  x.  10,  28 ;  xi.  25 ;  xiv.  6 ; 
XX.  31 ;  Acts  iii.  15 ;  Rom.  v.  15 — 21 ;  vi. 
8,  11,  23;  viii.  2;  xiv.  9;  1  Cor.  xv.  22; 
2  Cor.  iv.  10;  Phil.  i.  21;  Col.  iii.  4;  1 
Thess.  V.  10 ;  2  Tim.  i.  1,  10;  1  St.  John  i. 
1 ;  ii.  25  ;  iv.  9 ;  v.  11,  12,  20 ;  St.  Jude, 
ver.  21). 

9.  Peace  (Isa.  ix.  6  ;  Ezelc.  xxxiv.  25 ; 
Zech.  ix.  10  ;  St.  Luke  i.  79  ;  ii.  14  ;  xix.  38  ; 
St.  John  xiv.  27  ;  xvi.  33  ;  Acts  x.  36 ;  Rom. 
i.  7,  and  the  similar  passages,  and  v.  1 ;  x. 
15  ;  Eph.  ii.  14—17  ;  vi.  15 ;  Phil.  iv.  7 ; 
Col.  i.  20 ;  1  St.  Pet.  v.  14). 

10.  Blessing  (Gal.  iii.  14;  Eph.  i.  3;  2 
Tim.  iv.  22). 

11.  All  we  need  (Ps.  xxiii.  1 ;  St.  John 
XV.  7, 16;  1  Cor.  viii.  6  ;  Phil.  iv.  19). 

12.  Joy  and  consolation  (St.  Luke  ii.  25  ; 
St.  John  xvi.  20 ;  Eom.  v.  11 ;  xv.  13 ;  2  Cor. 
i.  5;  Phil.  ii.  1;  iii.  1;  iv.  4;  2  Thess.  ii. 
16). 

13.  Victory  (Rom.  viii.  37 ;  1  Cor.  xv. 
57 ;  2  Cor.  ii.  14 ;  1  St.  John  iv.  4 ;  v.  4,  5 ; 
Eev.  xii.  11). 

14.  The  kingdom  of  heaven  (St.  Luke 
xxii.  28,  29 ;  St.  John  xiv.  3 ;  Eph.  ii.  6 ; 
v.  5 ;  1  Thess.  iv.  17  ;  2  Tim.  ii.  12  ;  iv.  8 ; 
2  St.  Pet.  i.  11 ;  Eev.  iii.  21 ;  xxi.  22). 

IV.  Through  Him  we  are, 

1.  Eeconciled  to  God  (Dan.  ix.  24 ;  St. 
John  xi.  52  ;  Eom.  v.  1,  10  ;  xi.  15 ;  2  Cor. 

V.  18,  19 ;  Eph.  i.  10 ;  ii.  13,  16 ;  'iii.  6 ; 
Col.  i.  20,  21;  Heb.  ii.  17;  1  St.  John  iv. 
10). 

2.  Made  sons  of  God  (Isa.  Ivi.  5 ;  St.  Luke 


LORD 

xii.  32  ;  St.  John  i.  12 ;  Gal.  iii.  26 ;  iv.  5—7  r 
Bph.  i.  5 ;  1  St.  John  iiL  1). 

V.  Through  Him  we  must, 

1.  Offer  thanks  (Rom.  i.  8;  vii.  25;. 
Eph.  i.  6 ;  V.  20 ;  Col.  iii.  17 ;  1  Thess.  v.. 
18 ;  Heb.  xiii.  15 ;  1  St.  Pet.  ii.  5). 

2.  Give  glory  to  God  (St.  John  xiv.  13  ; 
Eom.  xvi.  27 ;  2  Cor.  viii.  23 ;  Eph.  iii.  21 ;, 
1  St.  Pet.  iv.  11). 

3.  Be  accepted  (Eph.  i.  6). 

VI.  In  Him  we  must, 

1.  Have  faith  (Isa.  xxviii.  16 ;  St.  John' 
i.  12  ;  iii.  16  ;  vi.  29, 47  ;  xx.  31 ;  Acts  xvi.. 
31 ;  xviii.  8 ;  xx.  21 ;  xxiv.  24 ;  Eom.  ix. 
33 ;  X.  9 ;  Gal.  ii.  16  ;  Eph.  ii.  8 ;  Phil,  i., 
29 ;  2  Tim.  i.  13 ;  1  St.  John  ii.  22  ;  iii.  23  ; 
V.  1,  10). 

2.  Hope  (Acts  xxviii.  20;  1  Cor.  xv^ 
19;  CoLi.  27;  1  Tim.  i.  1). 

3.  Trust  (2  Cor.  i.  20;  iii.  4;  xi.  10; 
Eph.  i.  12). 

4.  Die  (Rom.  vii.  4;  viii.  10,  36 ;  1  Cor. 
iv.  9  ;  ix.  15 ;  xv.  31 ;  2  Cor.  i.  5  ;  iv.  10 ; 
1 ;  vi.  9  :  Phil.  ii.  30). 

2.  Become  new  creatures  (2  Cor.  iv.  16 ; 
V.  17 ;  Gal.  vi.  15). 

6.  Have  our  conversation  (St.  John  xv. 
16,  22  ;  Eom.  vi.  4 ;  viii.  9  ;  xiii.  14 ;  1  Coir, 
iii.  23;  2  Cor.  iv.  10;  xiii.  5;  Gal.  i.  lO^;. 
ii.  17  ;  v.  24 ;  Eph.  iii.  19 ;  iv.  15 ;  vi.  6  ; 
Phil.  i.  10,  11,  27;  ii.  5,21;  iii.  18;  Col., 
i.  10 ;  ii.  6  ;  iii.  1,  16 ;  1  Thess.  ii.  11,  12  ;. 
iv.  1;  2  Tim.  ii.  1—3,  19  ;  Tit.ii.  10;  Heb.. 
ix.  14 ;  1  St.  Pet.  iii.  16 ;  Rev.  vii.  14). 

VII.  In  His  name, 

1.  We  are  exhorted  (1  Cor.  i.  10;  iii„ 
1;  V.  4;  1  Thess.  iv.  1,  2;  1  Tim.  v.  21;, 
vi.  13 ;  2  Tim.  iv.  1). 

2.  We  must  speak  (Rom.ix.  1,  2 ;  2  Cor., 
ii.  17  ;  xii.  19  ;  1  Tim.  ii.  7). 

3.  We  must  ask  (St.  Matt,  xviii.  19,  20,; 
St.  John  xiv.  13 ;  xv.  7 ;  xvi.  23, 24 ;  2  Cok_ 
xii.  8,  9 ;  1  St.  John  v.  14,  15). 

VIII.  We  must, 

1.  Acknowledge  His  power  (Isa.  Lxiii;. 
1—6 ;  St.  John  v.  23 :  Eom.  xiv.  11 ;  Phil.  iL 
10,  11 ;  Eev.  v.  13). 

2.  Confess  His  name  (St.  Matt.  x. '32; 
St.  Luke  xii.  8, 9  ;  Acts  viii.  37  ;  Phil.  ii.  11 ; 
1  St.  John  iv.  15 ;  2  St.  John,  ver.  7  ;  Eev. 
ii.  13;  iii.  8). 

3.  And  in  His  name  do  all  things  (Eph. 
vi.  7  ;  Col.  iii.  17,  23). 

IX.  In  Him  we  are  united. 

Eom.  viii.  17,  39  ;  xii.  5  ;  xvi.  7,  9—13 ; 
1  Cor.  i.  13  ;  iii.  1  ;  vi.  15  ;  vii.  22  ;  x.  17  ; 
xii.  13,  20,  27 ;  2  Cor.  xii.  2 ;  Gal.  i.  22  ; 
iii.  27,  28 ;  Eph.  i.  10,  22,  23 ;  ii.  14,  16, 
21 ;  iii.  6  ;  iv.  12,  16,  20,  25  ;  v.  30  ;  Col.. 


LORD'S  DAY 

i.  18,  24 ;   1  Thess.  iv.  16  ;  Heb.  iii.  14  ; 
1  St.  John  i.  3 ;  v.  20. 

X.  For  Him  we  must  suffer. 

St.  Matt.  V.  11, 12  ;  xvi.  24 ;  Acts  xiv.  22  ; 
Eom.  V.  3 ;  viii.  17  ;  1  Cor.  iv.  9 ;  2  Cor. 
i.  5;  iv.  10;  vi.  10;  vii.  4;  xii.  10;  Gal. 
ii.  20;  Phil.  i.  12;  iii.  8;  Col.  i.  24;  1 
Thess.  iii.  3;  2  Tim.  ii.  11,  12;  iii.  12; 
Heb.  X.  34 ;  xi.  26 ;  xiii.  13  ;  St.  James  i.  2  ; 
1  St.  Pet.  i.  6  ;  ii.  21 ;  iv.  13, 14,  16  ;  Kev.  i. 
9 ;  ii.  3. 

XI.  He  judgeth  all  things. 

St.  John  V.  22  ;  Acts  xvii.  31 ;  Rom.  ii.  16 ; 
xiv.  10 ;  1  Cor.  iv.  5  ;  2  Cor.  v.  10 ;  2  Tim. 
iv.  1 ;  1  St.  Pet.  iv.  5  ;  St.  Jude,  ver.  14, 15  ; 
Ptev.  XX.  12. 

LORD'S  DAT  (See  also  Sunday).  The 
first  day  of  the  week  is  so  designated  in 
the  Christian  Church; — it  is  the  KvpiaKT) 
rjiiipa  of  St.  John  and  Ignatius  (see  Schhv^ 
sner  in  voo.) ; — and  as  Friday  is  appointed 
as  the  weekly  fast,  in  commemoration  of 
our  Lord's  crucifixion,  so  is  Sunday  the 
weekly  feast,  in  commemoration  of  His 
resurrection. 

God  has  commanded  us  to  dedicate  at 
least  a  seventh  portion  of  our  time  to  him. 
We  read  in  Genesis  (ii.  3),  that  God  blessed 
the  seventh  day  and  sanctified  it.  Here  we 
are  told  that  the  seventh  day,  or  as  we  shall 
presently  show,  one  day  in  seven,  was  not 
only  blessed,  but  sanctified  by  God.  Now, 
by  sanctifying  a  thing  or  person,  we  under- 
stand their  being  separated  or  set  apart  for 
a  religious  purpose.  When  therefore  the 
Almighty  is  said  to  sanctify  a  portion  of 
time,  it  cannot  be  in  reference  to  himself,  to 
whom  all  days,  times,  and  seasons  are  alike 
— equally  pure,  equally  holy, — but  in  re- 
ference to  man ;  and  the  sanctifying  a  day 
must,  consequently,  imply  a  command  to 
man  to  keep  it  holy.  That  one  day  in  seven 
was  from  the  beginning  dedicated  to  the 
service  of  the  Almighty,  will  receive  con- 
firmation by  reference  to  the  chapter  which 
immediately  follows  that  from  which  the 
quotation  just  made  is  taken.  For  there  we 
are  told  that  Cain  and  his  brother  Abel  made 
a  sacrifice, — ^not,  "  in  the  process  of  time  " 
merely, — ^but,  as  it  is  given  in  the  margin 
of  our  Bibles,  "  at  the  end  of  the  days." 
The  latter  reading  we  prefer,  because,  while 
the  former  conveys  but  an  indistinct  idea  to 
the  mind,  the  latter  is  confirmed  by  one  of 
the  oldest  versions  of  Scripture,  namely,  the 
Septuagint.  But  if  to  this  expression, — "  at 
the  end  of  the  days,"  we  attach  any  meaning 
at  all,  it  must  surely  signify  at  the  end  of 
the  six  days  of  labour,  that  is,  on  the 
seventh  day,  previously  sanctified  by  the 
Almighty.  When,  in  addition  to  this,  we 
take  into  consideration  the  evil  character  of 


LORD'S  DAY 


457 


Cain,  it  seems  less  probable  that  he  should 
have  come  voluntarily  forward,  with  a 
grateful  heart,  to  worship  his  Maker,  than 
that  he  carelessly  complied  with  a  custom 
to  which  he  had  been  habituated  from  his- 
childhood :  he  came  to  sacrifice,  as  some 
come  now  to  Church,  after  each  interval  of 
six  days,  from  habit  rather  than  piety. 

A  passage  in  the  book  of  Job  may  also- 
be  taken  as  corroborating  evidence  of  the- 
early  observance  of  the  Sabbath.  Job  is- 
generally  supposed  to  have  lived  before  the 
time  of  Moses ;  and  in  the  Book  of  Job  we 
find  mention  made  of  "  the  day  on  which 
the  sons  of  God  came  to]  present  themselves 
unto  the  Lord,"  which  we  may  fairly  con- 
clude alludes  to  the  Sabbath.  It  is  remark- 
able, also,  that  we  find  some  traces  of  this- 
institution  among  the  heathen,  for  two  of 
their  oldest  poets,  Homer  and  Hesiod,  speak 
of  the  seventh  as  being  a  sacred  day.  It  is 
probable  that  in  the  same  manner  in  whicli 
they  obtained  the  notion  of  a  Deity,  namely,, 
by  tradition  from  father  to  son  of  a  revelation 
made  to  Adam  and  Noah,  they  arrived  at  a. 
knowledge  which  gradually  died  away,  of 
this  saoredness  of  the  seventh  day. 

But  when  we  remember  that  this  rule- 
was  given  to  Adam,  and  was,  in  conse- 
quence, binding,  not  upon  a  chosen  few,  but 
upon  all  his  descendants,  it  does  not  appear 
likely  that  any  one  particular  day  was  de- 
signated, but  merely  that  a  general  rule  was 
laid  do\vn  that  one  day  in  seven  should  bo- 
dedicated  to  direct  oflSces  of  religious  duties ; 
for  it  would  have  been  impossible  for  men, 
scattered,  as  they  were  soon  to  be,  over  all 
the  face  of  the  earth,  to  observe,  all  of  them, 
the  same  day,  since  the  beginning  of  every 
day,  and  of  course  of  the  seventh,  must  have 
been  eighteen  hours  later  in  some  parts  of 
the  world  than  in  Eden  or  Palestine,  or 
wherever  we  suppose  the  Sabbath  to  have 
been  first  established.  A  law  for  a  single- 
nation  may  be  particular ;  a  law  for  all  man- 
kind must  be  general :  the  principle  must 
be  laid  down  and  enforced;  the  particulars 
must  depend  upon  circumstances.  Besides, 
although  it  is  easy  to  demonstrate  that  the 
Israelites  ought  to  have  set  apart  for  their 
religious  duties  one  day  in  seven,  previously 
to  the  ceremonial  institution  of  the  Sabbath 
on  Mount  Sinai,  yet  it  is  equally  clear  that 
they  did  not  keep  the  same  day  hefore  the 
dehvery  of  the  law,  as  they  did  afterwards. 
For  although  in  the  16th  chapter  of  Exodus,, 
previously  to  the  dehvery  of  the  law,  the- 
Sabbath  is  spoken  of  as  an  institution  well 
known  to  the  Israelites,  yet  as  to  the  particular 
day  on  which  it  was  kept  there  is  no  mention: 
made.  It  was  not  till  afteewaeds  that 
one  certain  particular  day  was  appointed 
(namely,  that  on  which  they  came  out  of 
Egypt);   for  the  two-fold  purpose,  that  a^. 


■458 


LORD'S  DAY 


men  they  might  commemorate  the  creation, 
and  as  Israelites  celebrate  their  deliverance. 
JSTow  we  may  reasonably  infer  that  they 
would  not  have  set  out  from  Egypt  on  the 
■Sabbath  day,  and  that  consequently  their 
Sabbath  was  not  observed  at  the  same  time 
hefore,  as  it  was  after,  its  re-institulion  on 
Mount  Sinai  (cf.  Exod.  xx.  10 ;  Deut.  v.  15). 

That  we,  then,  together  with  every  human 
being,  are  bound  to  dedicate  one  day  in  seven 
■to  religious  duties,  is  evident,  because  the 
"Commandment  was  given,  not  to  Moses,  but 
to  Adam ;  not  to  the  Israelites,  but  to  all  the  - 
•descendants  of  Eve;  But  the  observance  of 
that  one  particular  day  sanctified  to  the  Jews, 
not  only  to  celebrate  the  universal  love  of 
God  in  the  creation  of  the  world,  but  his 
special  loving-kindness  to  their  .individual 
.nation,  is  not  any  longer  obUgatory  upon  us, 
because  it  formed  part  of  the  ceremonial  law. 
It  remains,  therefore,  now  to  inquire  on  what 
.authority  it  is  that  we  observe  the  first  day 
■of  the  week  in  preference  to  any  other,  or,  in 
other  words,  by  whom  the  festival  of  the 
Lord's  day  was  instituted. 

That  we  in  the  present  age,  keep  the  first 
day  of  the  week  as  a  holy-3.ay  dedicated  to 
the  service  of  our  Maker  and  Eedeetner  is 
•certain  ;  the  question  is,  whether  this  custom 
-dates  from  primitive  times,  or  is  of  mediaeval 
date. 

Now,  that  the  gospel  does  not  expressly 
•command  the  religious  observance  of  the  first 
•day  in  the  week  must  be  conceded.  The 
apostles  and  Jewish  Christians  do  not  appear 
ito  have  neglected  the  Jewish  Sabbath.  As 
long  as  the  temple  continued  standing,  they 
kept  the  last  day  of  the  week  as  a  fast ;  the 
first,  as  a  festival.  That  the  apostles  did 
keep  the  first  day  of  the  week  as  a  festival,  is 
quite  clear.  St.  Paul,  we  are  told,  preached 
at  Troas,  "  on  the  first  day  of  the  week." 
When  all  the  disciples  had,  as  they  were  in 
ithe  habit  of  doing,  ",come  together  to  break 
"bread,"  that  is,  to  receive  the  Holy  Eucharist, 
which  ought  always  to  form  a  part  of  the 
public  service,  he  gave  orders  also  to  the 
'Corinthians  to  make  a  collection  for  the  saints 
at  Jerusalem,  when,  according  to  theh 
custom,  they  assembled  together  on  the  first 
•day  of  the  week,  which  day  is  expressly 
c.iUed  by  St.  John  the  Lord's  day  (Rev.  i. 
10).  But  if  the  testimony  of  man  is  great, 
ithe  testimony  of  God  is  greater.  Their  obser- 
vance of  this  festival  was  sanctioned  by  our 
Lord  Himself,  by  His  repeated  appearance 
among  His  apostles  on  that  day  ;  after  His 
resurrection  it  is  sanctioned  by  the  Holy 
Ghost,  by  the  miraculous  effusion  of  the 
.Spirit  upon  the  apostles  when  they  were 
together  on  the  day  of  Pentecost,  which 
must,  that  year,  have  fallen  upon  the  first 
<iay  of  the  week.  Now,  take  these  facts  of 
•Scripture   (and   others  may  be  found)  and 


LORD'S  PRAYER 

compare  them  with  the  universal  tradition  of 
the  Church,  and  surely  we  must  agree  with 
one  of  the  most  celebrated  divines  who  have 
appeared  iu  modem  times,  when  speaking  of 
the  most  important  doctrine  of  our  rehgion, 
that  of  the  'Trinity,  "  if  what  appears  pro- 
hahly  to  be  taught  in  Scripture  appears 
certainly  ia  have  been  taught  in  the  primi- 
tive and  Catholic  Church,  such  probability, 
so  strengthened,  carries  with  it  the  force  of 
demonstration." 

In  examining  such  writers  as  lived  in  the 
age  of  the  apostles,  or  those  immediately 
succeeding,  we  find  them  alluding  to  the 
fact  (and  their  testimony  is  confirmed  by 
contemporary  and  heathen  historians,  e.g. 
Pliny,  lib.  x.  Ep.  97),  that  Christians  were 
always  accustomed  to  meet  on  the  first  day 
of  the  week  for  the  performance  of  their 
religious  exercises.  If  we  examine  them 
more  minutely,  we  find  that,  as  the  Jewish 
Sabbath  was  fixed  to  a  certain  day,  on 
account  of  their  deliverance  from  Pharaoh, 
so  the  Christians  kept  this  festival  in  grate- 
ful acknowledgment  of  the  mercies  of  the 
Redeemer,  who,  as  on  this  day,  accomplished 
the  victory  over  the  grave,  by  rising  from 
the  dead.  If  we  attend  them  yet  further, 
we  find  those  who,  too  honest  to  deceive, 
lived  too  near  the  apostolic  age  to  be  deceived, 
asserting  that  this  festival  was  instituted  by 
the  apostles ;  and  if  by  the  apostles,  who 
acted  under  the  immediate  direction  and 
influence  of  the  Holy  Ghost,  then  of  course 
we  may  conclude  that  the  institution  was 
Divine. — Ignat.  Ep.  ad  Magnes.  n.  9 ;  Justin 
Mart.  Apol.  i.  67  :  ii.  99;  TertulL  Apol.  c. 
16 ;  de  Cor.  Mil.  3,  &c.  ;  Clem.  Alex.  Strom. 
7 ;  Jeremy  Taylor,  vol.  xii.  p.  ■423 ;  Dr. 
Hessey's  Hampton  Lectures,  where  a  different 
view  is  taken  of  the  institution  of  the 
Sabbath ;  Art.  in  Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible 
(See  Suthday'). 

LORD'S  PRAYER.  The  prayer  which 
our  blessed  Lord  Himself  has  taught  us.  It 
is  to  be  used  as  a  model  for  all  our  devotions, 
our  blessed  Lord  saying  (St.  Matt.  vi.  9), 
"After  this  inanner  pray  ye ; "  and  it  is  to 
be  used  in  express  words  whenever  we  pray, 
our  Lord  commanding  us  (St.  Luke  xi.  2), 
"When  ye  pray,  say.  Our  Father,"  &c. 
Therefore  the  Church  of  Christ  hath  used 
from  the  first  to  begin  and  end  her  services 
with  the  Lord's  Prayer.  This  being  the 
foundation  upon  which  all  other  prayers 
should  be  built,  therefore,  as  .Tertullian  says, 
we  begin  ■(vith  it,  that  so,  the  right  founda- 
tion being  laid,  we  may  justly,  proceed  to 
our  ensuing  requests.  And  as  .it  is  the 
perfection  cf  all  prayer,  therefore,  says 
St.  Augusthie, .  we  conclude  our  .  prayers 
with  it.  Let  no  man,  therefore,  quarrel 
with  the  -Church's  frequent  use  of  the 
Lord's  Prayer,  for  the  Catholic  Church  ever 


LORD'S  PEAYER 

did  tlie  same.  Besides,  as  St.  Cyprian 
observes,  if  we  would  hope  to  have  our 
prayers  accepted  of  the  Father  only  for  His 
bon's  sake,  why  should  we  not  hope  to  have 
them  most  speedily  accepted  when  they  are 
offered  up  in  His  Son's  own  words  ? 

It  is  objected  by  some  persons  in  the 
present  day  (for  the  objection  was  unknown 
to  the  primitive  Church),  that  our  Saviour 
did'  not  give  this  as  an  express /orm  of 
grayer,  but  only  as  a  pattern,;  or  direction. 
In  support  of  this  they  quote  the  passage, 
St.  Matt.  vi.  9,  &c.,  in  which  it  is  introduced, 
"  After  this  manner  pray  ye ;"  not  laying  so 
much  stress  onthe  similar  passage,  St.  Luke 
xi.  2,  &c.,  where  our  Saviour  expressly 
says,  "'When  ye  pray,  say."  On  this  it 
may  be  remarked,  that  where  there  are  two 
texts  on  any  particular  doctrine,  or  practice, 
the  one  worded  ambiguously,  as  in  that  of 
St.  Matthew,  "  After  this  manner,"  &c.  (or 
as  the  translation  would  more  properly  be, 
"  Pray  tlius^  and  the  ambiguity  would  then 
almost  vanish),  and  the  other  clearly  ex- 
pressed ;  as  in  that  of  St.  Luke,  "  When  ye 
pray,  say,"  it  is  a  settled  and  a  natural  ■  rule 
of  interpretation,  that  the  doubtful  words 
should  be  explained  by  those  which  are 
clear.  Now  he  who  uses  these  very  words 
as  a  form,  acts  in  evideat  obedience  to  both 
the  letter  and  the  spirit  of  the  one  precept, 
and  yet  not  in  contradiction  to  the  other. 
But  he  who  rejects  this  as  a  form,  though 
he  may  act  in  obedience  to  the  spirit  of  the 
one,  certainly  acts  in  disobedience  to  the 
letter,  if  not  to  the  spirit  of  the  other, 
"  When  ye  pray,  say,"  &o. 

Had  not  our  Lord  given  this  as  a  settled 
form  of  prayer,  He  would  have  been  very 
likely  to  have  dilated  somewhat  on  the 
various  subjects  it  embraces — of  adoration, 
prayer,  and  praise :  and  perhaps  have  intro- 
duced illustrations  according  to  His  cus- 
tom ;  and  would  not  improbably  have  said, 
■"  When  ye  pray,  address  yourselves  in  the 
first  place  to  God  who  is  your  heavenly 
Father,  but  forget  not  His  sovereignty,  and 
ask  Him  to  give  you,"  &c.  But  instead  of 
this  He  dictates,  in  both  cases,  a  few  compre- 
hensive sentences,  convenient  for  all  persons, 
and  under  all  circumstances,  and  of  which 
TertuUian  thus  exclaims,  "  In  this  compen- 
dium of  few  words,  how  many  declarations 
of  prophets,  evangelists,  and  apostles  are 
contained !  How  many  discourses,  parables, 
examples,  precepts  of  our  Lord !  How 
many  duties  towards  God  are  briefly  ex- 
pressed !  Honour  to  the  Father,  faith,  pro- 
fession in  His  name,  offering  of  obedience  in 
His  will,  expression  of  hope  in  His  kingdom ; 
petition  for  the  necessaries  of  life  in  the 
teead,  confession  of  sins  in  the  supplication, 
solicitation  against  temptations  in  the  asking 
of  protection.     What   wonder!   God  alone 


LORD'S  PEAYER 


459 


could  teach  how  He  chose  to  be  prayed  to." 
St.  Cyprian  says,  that  "  it  is  so  copious  in 
spiritual  virtue,  that  there  is  nothing  omitted 
in  all  our  prayers  and  petitions  which  is  not 
comprehended  in  this  epitome  of  heavenly 
doctrine.'-' 

It  is  necessary  to  be  understood  that  the 
transactions  mentioned  by  St.  Matthew  and 
St.  Luke  were-'nOt  one  and'  the  satne,'but 
occurred  at  different  times,  and  on  different 
occasions.  Our  Lord  first  introduced  this 
form  of  prayer  uncalled  for,  in  the  sermon 
on  the  mount,  at  the  commencement  of  his 
commission,  comprehending  a  doxology,  or 
concluding  tribute  of  glory  and  praise.  But 
he  gave  it  for  the  second  time,  after  an 
interval  of  about  two  years  and  a  half,  as  is 
ckar  from  the  various  events  that  oc(iurred, 
and  that'  are  enumerated  in-  the  chapters 
(St.  Luke  vii. — xi.)  which  form  the  greater 
part  of  the  acts  of  His  ministry. 

It  is  not  impossible  that  the  disciples 
themselves  did,  on  the  first  occasion,  regard 
it  as  conveying  a  general  idea  only  in  what 
terms  God  should  be  addressed,  and  there- 
fore not  having  used  it  as  a  common  prayer, 
the  circumstance  of  our  Lord's  "  praying  in 
a  certain  place  "  induced  one  of  His  disciples, 
"  when  He  ceased,"  to  say,  "  Lord,  teach  us 
to  pray,  as  John  also  taught  his  disciples ;" 
alluding  to  a  well  known  custom  of  the 
Hebrew  masters,  which  it  thus  appears  St. 
John  had  adopted,  of  teaching  their  scholars 
a  particular  form  of  words  in  their  addresses 
to  God,  varying,  no  doubt,  according  to 
their  particular  sentiments.  Our  Lord's 
disciples  here,  therefore,  ask  of  Him  a  pre- 
cise form,  and  that  form  He  gives  them  in 
compliance  with  their  wishes,  not  only  for 
their  use,  but  for  the  use  of  all  who  should 
embrace  the  profession  of  Christianity— 
"  When  ye  pray,  say,"  &c. 

It  is  supposed  by  some,  and  there  seems 
much  reason  for  the  idea,  that  the  disciple 
who  thus  asked  was  a  new  convert,  and  not 
present  at  the  delivery  of  the  sermon  on 
the  mount,  and  that  our  Lord  repeated 
the  form  which  He  had  then  before  given. 
Indeed,  if  that  which  was  first  given  had 
not  been  considered  as  a  settled  form,  or  a 
groundwork  for  it,  it  would  appear  extra- 
ordinary that  it  should  be  repeated  in  so 
nearly  the  same  words,  and  precisely  in  the 
same  order  of  sentences.  Grotius  remarks 
on  this  subject,  that  so  averse  was  our  Lord, 
the  Lord  of  the  Church  {tain  longe  ahfuit 
ipse  Dominus  ecclesix),  to  unnecessary  inno- 
vation, and  an  affectation  of  novelty,  that 
He  "  who  had  not  the  Spirit  by  measure," 
but  "  in  whom  were  all  the  hidden  treasures 
of  wisdom  and  knowledge,"  selected  the 
words  and  phrases  in  a  great  degree  from 
forms  of  prayer  then  well  known  among  the 
Jews ;  as  in  His  doctrines  He  also  made  use 


460 


LORD'S  PRAYER 


of  proverbs  and  sayings  well  understood  in 
that  age. 

Tlie  difference  between  tbe  form  given  in 
the  sermon  on  tbe  mount  on  that  second 
occasion  is,  that  to  tbe  latter  the  doxology 
is  not  affixed,  which  many  indeed,  suppose 
to  be  an  interpolation ;  leaving  this  perhaps 
to  be  added  according  to  the  occasion 
and  to  the  zeal  of  the .  w;orshipper..  It 
cannot  be  imagined  that  either  tbe  disciples 
of  our  Lord,  or  of  St.  John,  had  hitherto 
neglected  the  duty,  of  prayer,  or  that  they 
performed  it  in  an  uncertain  or  disorderly 
manner,  as  they  had  set  forms  and  hours  of 
prayer,  which  all  the  devout  Jews  observed ; 
it  seems  therefore  obvious  that  a  particular 
form  is  alluded  to  in  tbe  case  of  both,  and 
the  request  to  our  Lord  was  made  in 
pursuance  of  His  encouraging  direction, 
"  Ask,  and  ye  shall  have,"  and  was  gratified 
by  Him  in  compliance  with  the  reasonable 
and  well-known  existing  custom. 

Our  blessed  Lord  appears  afterwards  to 
refer  to  the  custom  now  adopted  by  His 
disciples,  and  the  well-known  forms  used, 
when  he  says,  "And  when  ye  stand  praying, 
forgive,  if  ye  have  aught  against  any :  that 
your  Father  also  which  is  in  heaven  may 
forgive  you  your  trespasses "  (St.  Mark  xi. 
26);  thus  pointedly  referring  to  two  of  its 
principal  features,  couched  too  in  the  same 
words.  The  Apostle  St.  Peter  seems  to 
make  the  same  allusion  when  he  says,  "  If 
ye  call  on  the  Father,"  &o.  (1  St.  Pet.  i.  17). 

Some  have  argued  that  this  prayer  is  to 
be  considered  as  temporary  only,  and  not  of 
perpetual  obligation,  because  we  do  not  in 
it  ask  in  the  name  of  Christ,  according  to 
His  direction ;  but  a  transaction  may  be 
opposed  to  this,  recorded  in  the  Acts  of  the 
Apostles  (iv.  24),  in  which  it  is  seen,  unless 
the  apostles  and  disciples  had  so  quickly 
forgotten  tbe  direction  of  their  Lord,  that 
prayers  may  be  considered  as  offered  up  in 
the  name  of  Christ,  though  addressed  to 
God ;  for  there  the  disciples,  on  the  libera- 
tion of  Peter  and  John  by  the  Jewish 
council,  lift  up  their  voice  and  say,  "  Lord, 
thou  art  God,  which  hast  made  heaven  and 
earth,  and  the  sea,  and  all  that  in  them  is;" 
and  they  mention  Christ  as  His  holy  child 
Jesus.  In  our  addresses  to  God,  our 
heavenly  Father,  we  cannot  forget  Him 
through  whom  we  have  access  as  to  a  father, 
being  "joint-heirs  with  him." 

Another  objection  is  made,  that  it  does 
not  appear  in  Scripture  that  the  apostles 
used  this  prayer;  but  to  this  it  may  be 
remarked,  that  neither  does  it  appear  they 
used  any  other  form,  and  yet  some  form  of 
words  must  have  been  generally  known  and 
used  by  them,  or  how  could  "  they  lift  up 
their  voice  with  one  accord  "  (Acts  iv.  24 ; 
i.  14). 


LORD'S  PRAYER 

Bishop  Jeremy  Taylor  {Apology  for  set 
forms  of  Liturgy,  §  86)  justly  says,  "That 
the  apostles  did  use  the  prayer  their  Lord 
taught  them,  I  think  need  not,  much  to  be 
questioned;  they  could  have  no. other  end 
of  their  desire;  and  it  had. been  a  strange 
boldness  to  ask  for  a  form  which  they  in- 
tended not  to  use,  or  a  strange  levity  not  to 
do  what  they  intended."  .  : 

Bingham  observes  (Book  xiii.  cb..7)  that 
if  there  were  no  other .  argument  to  prove 
the  lawfulness  of  set  forms  of  prayer  in  the 
judgment  of  the  ancients,  the,  opinion  which 
they  had  of  the  Lord's  Prayer,  and  their 
practice  pursuant  to  this  opinion,  -  would 
sufficiently  do  it ;  and  he  remarks  that  .they 
unequivocally  looked  upon  it  as  a  settled 
form:  for  TertuUian  says  expressly  that 
."  our  Lord  prescribed  a  new  form  of  prayer 
for  the  new  disciples  of  the  New  Testament, 
and  that  though  John  had  taught  his  dis- 
ciples a  form,  yet  that  he  did  this  only  as- 
a  forerunner  of  Christ,  so  that  when  Christ 
was  increased  ('  he  must  increase,  but  I 
must  decrease '),  then  the  work  of  the  ser- 
vant passed  over  to  the  Lord.  Thus  the 
prayer  of  John  is  lost,  while  that  of  .our 
Lord  remains,  that  earthly  things  may  give 
way  to  heavenly." 

In  similar  tenns  speaks  Irenseus  (who 
had  himself  heard  Polycarp,  the  disciple  of 
St.  John,)  Origen,  Tertullian,  St.  Cyprian, 
St.  Cyril,  St.  Jerome,  St.  Chrysostom,  and 
St.  Augustine.  The  last  says  expressly 
(de  Verb.  Apostol.  &  Epist.  89  ad  Hilariurn), 
that  as  the  Church  always  .used  this  prayer, 
she  did  it  at  the  commandment  of  Christ. 
"  He  said  to  His  disciples — He  said  to  His 
apostles  and  to  us,  pray  thus."  St.  Chrysos- 
tom refers  continually  to  the  Lord's  Prayer, 
as  in  common  use  among, them  by  the  ex- 
press commandment  of  Christ,  and  observes, 
"  that  the  Father  well  knows  the  words  and 
meaning  of  His  Son."  St.  Cyprian,  de  Orat. 
Domin.,  says,  "  Let  the  Father  recognise  in 
your  prayers  the  words  of  the  Son ;"  and  he 
considers  it  as  a  peculiar  instance  of  mercy, 
"  that  He  who  made  us  taught  us '  how 
to  pray ;  that  whilst  we  speak  unto  the- 
Father  in  that  prayer  and  address  which 
the  Son  taught  us,  we  may  the  more  easily 
be  heard."  He  adds,  "Since  we  have  an 
Advocate  with  the  Father  for  our  sins,  we 
should,  whenever  we  pray  for  pardon,  allege 
unto  God  the  very,  words  which  our  Advo- 
cate has  taught  us.  We  have  His  promise, 
that  whatever  we  shall  ask  in  His  name  w& 
shall  receive :  and  must  we  not  more  readily 
obtain  our  desires,  when  we  not  only  use  His 
name  in  asking,  but  in  His  very  words, 
present  our  request  unto  God.  Our  Advo- 
cate in  heaven  has  taught  us  to  say  this 
prayer  upon  earth,  that  between.  His  inter- 
cession   and    our    supplications    the    most 


LORD'S  PRAYER 

perfect  harmony  may  subsist."  Hooker  (Bk. 
V.  ch.  35)  observes,  that  "  should  men  speak 
with  the  tongues"  of  augels,  yet  words  so 
pleasing  to  the  ears  of  God,  as  those  which 
the  Son  of  God  Himself  has  composed,  it 
■were  not  possible  for  man  to  frame." 

There  was,  iadeed,  hardly  any  office  in 
the  primitive  Church  iu  which  the  celebra- 
tion of  this  prayer  did  not  make  a  solemn 
part ;  so  that  at  length  it  was  called  the 
Oratio  quotidiana,  the  daily,  the  common 
prayer;  the  Oratio  legitima,  the  establish- 
ed prayer,  or  the  prayer  of  the  Christian 
law;  the  "  epitome  of  the  gospel :  "  and  St. 
Augustine  even  terms  it,  "the  daily  bap- 
tism,"-and  a  "daily  purification,"  "for," 
says  he, "  we  are  absolved  once  by  baptism, 
but  by  this  prayer  daily."-  -When  in  suc- 
ceeding ages  some  of  the  clergy  in  Spain 
occasionally  omitted  it  in  the  daily  service, 
they  were  censured  by  a  council, 'as  "proud 
contemners  of  the  Lord's  injunction ;  and 
it  was  enacted,  that  every  clergyman  omit- 
ting it  either  in  private  or  public  jjrayer 
should  be  degraded  from  the  dignity  of  his 
office."  It  is  worthy  of  remark,  that  the 
heathen  writer  Lucian,  '  nearly  contempo- 
rary with  the  apostles,  makes  a  Christian, 
in  one  of  his  dialogues,  speak  of  the  prayer 
which  began,  "  Our  Father." 

The  early  Fathers  were  even  of  opinion, 
that  the  making  use  of  this  prayer  was  of 
vast  efficacy  to  incline  God  to  pardon  sins 
of  infirmity,  especially  those  committed 
through  want  of,  fervour  and  sufficient  at- 
tention in  our  other  prayers.  "As  for  our 
daily  and  slight  sics,"  says  St.  Augustine, 
■"  without  which  no  one  can  live,  the  daily 
prayer  will  be  accepted  by  God  for  pardon 
of  them ;"  and  the  fourth  Council  of  Toledo 
enjoins  it  for  this  among  other  reasons. 
This  doctrine  the  Papists  afterwards  per- 
verted, by  their  distinction  of  sins  into 
venial  and  mortal,  and  by  the  pure  opus 
operatum  of  repeating  the  Lord's  Prayer. 
Of  this  abuse  there  is  happily  no  shadow  in 
the  present  service  of  our  Church,  our  re- 
formers having  wholly  rejected  and  abol- 
ished the  technical  repetition  ■  of  it  (the 
Faternoster)  with  chaplets  and  rosaries,  to 
which  truly  "  vain  repetitions  "  the  Church 
of  Bome  had  annexed  indulgences. 

In  conclusion,  in  whatever  else  the  various 
liturgies  dififer,  they  all  agree  in  the  constant 
and  frequent  use  of  this  prayer.  Dr.  Featly 
says,  "  the  reformed  Churches  generally 
conclude  their  prayers  before  sermon  with 
the  Lord's  Prayer,  partly  in  opposition  to 
the  Papists,  who  close  up  their  devotions 
with  an  Ave  Maria,  partly  to  supply  all  the 
■defects  and  imperfections  of  their  own." 
And  Bingham  pointedly  declares,  "  I  dare 
midertake  to  prove,  that  for  1500  years 
together,  none  ever  disliked  the  use  of  the 


LORD'S  PRAYER 


461 


Lord's  Prayer,  but  only  the  Pelagians; 
and  they  did  not  wholly  reject  the  use 
of  it  neither,  nor  dislike  it  because  it  was 
a  form,  but  for  another  reason,  because 
it  contradicted  one  of  their  principal  tenets, 
which  was,  that  some  men  were  so  perfect 
in  this  world,  that  they  needed  not  to  pray 
to  God  for  the  forgiveness  of  their  own  sins, 
but  only  for  those  of  others." 

II.  The  Lord's  Prayer  is  to  he  said  with  an 
audible  voice. — It  was  an  ancient  custom 
for  the  priest ,  to  say  some  parts  of  the  li- 
turgy internally  (secreto,  Iv  iavrm,  of 
/ivcn-iK<3y),  in  an  unintelligible  whisper ;  and 
in  some  instances  the  people  joined  in  this 
manner,  as  was  the  case  with  respect  to 
the  Lord's  Prayer  and  the  Creed.  This 
unreasonable  practice  was  put  an  end  to 
at  the  Reformation,  and  the  Lord's  Prayer 
in  particular  was  directed  to  be  said  "  with 
an  audible  voice,"  "with  a  loud  voice;" 
probably  that  the  people  might  sooner 
learn  this  most  essential  prayer ;  a  prac- 
tice from  which  the  ignorant  may  even  now 
find  benefit. ' 

The  people  are  to  repeat  it  with  tlie  priest. 
— When  the  Lord's  Prayer  was  directed 
to  be  said  with  an  audible  voice,  it  was 
in  the  Romish  Church,  said  by  the  priest 
alone ;  but  in  the  Greek  and  ancient  Gtii- 
lican  Churches,  by  the  priest  and  people 
together — a  custom  which  the  Church  of 
England  has  adopted  in  preference  to  the 
Roman.  Until  the  review  of  1661,  the  min- 
ister began  the  prayer,  and  went  through  it 
alone  to  the  conclusion  of  the  last  petition, 
"  but  deliver  us  from  evil,"  which  the 
people  said ;  in  order,  as  Bishop  Sparrow 
remarks,  that  they  might '  not  be  inter- 
rupted from  bearing  a  part  in  so  divine  a 
prayer.  In  a  rubric  in  the  Communion 
Service,  near  the  conclusion,  the  manner  in 
which  the  Lord's  Prayer  should  be  used  is 
clearly  laid  down.  "Then  shall  the  priest 
say  the  Lord's  Prayer,  the  people  repeat- 
ing after  him  every  petition." 

In  the  English  Prayer  Book  the  Lord's 
Prayer  occurs  twice' in  the  daily  offices,, 
once  in  the  Litany,  and  twice  in  the  office  for 
Holy  Communion. 

In  none  of  the  successive  editions  of  the 
Prayer  Book  till  the  last  review,  .was  there 
any  direction  for  'the  people  prefixed  to 
the  first  occurrence  of  the  Lord's  Prayer. 
In  King  Edward's  First  Book  at  its  se- 
cond recurrence,  after  the  Creed,  the  latter 
clause,  "  but  deliver  us  from  evil,"  was  in- 
serted. This  was  altered  in  the  Second 
Book  of  King  Edward;  and  the  direction, 
"  Then  the  minister,  clerks  and  people," 
&c.,  inserted,  as  we  have  it  now.  In  the 
Litany,  the  two  last  clauses  were  marked 
as  verse  and  response,  till  the  last  review. 
In  the  Communion  no  direction  was  given 


462 


LORD'S  PRAYER 


for  the  people ; — at  its  second  occurrence, 
the  verse  and  response  were  marked,  as  in 
the  Litany  :  but  in  the  Second  Boole,  the 
people  were  directed  to  repeat  after  him 
every  petition,  as  now.  The  Scotch  Prayer 
Book  (temp.  K.  Chas.  I.)  first  inserted  the 
doxology,  at  each  occurrence  of  the  prayer 
in  Morning  and  Evening  Service,  and  at  its 
last  in  the  Communion.  At  the  last  review 
the  dosology  was  inserted  at  its  first  occur- 
rence in  the  Morning  and  Evening  Prayer, 
and  at  the  end  of  the  Communion ;  and  the 
versicular  arrangement  in.  the  Litany  .was 
altered.  The  notation  of  the  verse  and 
response,  with,  their  proper  cadences,  is  .re- 
tained in  the  old  choral  manuals. 

Wheatly  remarks  that  "the  doxology 
was  appointed  by  the  last  review  to  be  used 
in  this  place,  partly,  he  supposes,  because, 
many,  copies  of  St.  Matthew  have  it,  and 
the  Greek  Fathers  expound  it ;  and  partjy' 
because  the  office  here  is,  a  matter  of  praise, 
it  being  used  immediately  after  the  absolu- 
tion." And  again,  in  the  Post  Communion, 
"the  doxology  is  here  annexed,  because  all 
these  devotions  are  designed  for  an  act  of 
praise,  for  the  benefits  received,  in  the  Holy 
Sacrament."  And  in  the  Churching  of 
Women,'  "  the  doxology  was  added  to  the 
Lord's  Prayer  at  the  last  review,  by  reason 
of  its  being  an  office  of  .thanksgiving  "  (See 
Doxology). 

In  the  Eomish  service,  except  in  the 
Mass,  the  priest  speaks  the  words,  "Et  ne 
nos,"  &c.;  "  Lead  us  not  into  temptation," 
in  a  peculiar  tone  of  voice,  by  which  the 
people  are  apprized  of  its  being  the  time  for 
them'to  answer,  "  But  deliver  us  from  evil." 
This  also  is  a  custom  at  the  end  of  every 
prayer,  tha,t  ,the  people  may  know  when  to 
say  "  Amen." ,  In  the.  Mosarabio  liturgy  .the 
priest  says,  the  prayer  by  himself,,  and  the 
people  answer  "  Amen  "  to  each  petition. 

The  catechumpns  and  the  energumens,  or 
those  possessed  .with  evil  spirits,  were  not 
suffered  inthe  primitive.  Church  to  join  in 
the  tremendous  cry  sent  up  by  the  people, 
but  oply  bowed ,  tbeir  heads  in  token  of 
assent. 

It"  may  be  'observed  that  the  several 
paragraphs  of  the  Lord's  Prayer. are  made 
to  begin,  in  our  Church  Prayer  Book,  with 
a,  capital  letter,  in  "order,  most;  probably,  to 
inark  accurately  the  plapes  where  the  people 
should  take  up  their  parts ;  and  this  method 
is  adopted' in  the  confession  in  the  daily 
sei-vice,  in  the  creeds,  the  Gloria  in  Excelsis, 
in  the  Communion  Service,  and  in  the 
confession  and  deprecation  in  the  Com- 
mination  Service  on  Ash  'Wednesday. 

But  it  must  likewise  be  observed,  that 
this  method  does  not  seem  to  be  so  closely 
followed  in  the  Cambridge  as  in  the  Oxford 
books,  the  former  combining  the  fourth  and 


LORD'S  SUPPER 

fifth  paragraphs,  the  seventh  and  eighth, 
and  the  eleventh,  twelfth,  and  thirteenth  in 
the  Lord's  Prayer ;  and  yet  in  these  copies 
the  word  "and"  is  retained  before  "the 
power,"  &c.,  but  dropped  in  the  latter. 

To  make  this  matter  clear,  however,  we 
subjoin  the  prayer  as  printed  and  pointed  in 
the  sealed  books,  at  the  beginning  of  Morn- 
ing and  Evening  Prayer. 

Our  Father,  which  art  in  Heaven,  Hal- 
lowed be  thy  Name.  Thy  Kingdom  come. 
Thy  will  be  done  in  Earth,  As,  it  is  in 
Heaven.  Give  us  this  day  our  daily  bread. 
And'forgive  us  our  trespasses.  As  we  forgive 
them,  that  trespass  against  us.  And  lead  us 
not  into  temptation;  But  deliver  us' from 
evil :  For  thine  is  the  Kingdom,  the  Power, 
And  the  Glory,  For  ever  and  ever.     Amen. 

Here  OTid  before  the  Power  is,  in  all  the 
collated  copies  of  sealed  books,  crossed  out 
with  a  pen,  both  in  the  Morning  and  Even- 
ing.Prayer. 

In  the  Post  Communion  Service,  there  is 
some  difference  of  punctuation  and  of  type : 
e.g.  Our  Father  which  art  in  heaven  ;  Hal- 
lowed be  thy  Name.  Thy  Kingdom  come. 
Thy  will  be  done  in  ea,rth.  As  it  is  in 
heaven.  Give  us  this  day  our  daily  bread. 
And  forgive  us  our  trespasses.  As  we  forgive 
them  that  trespass  against  us^  And  .lead  us 
not  into  temptation :  But  deliver  us  from 
evil.  For  thine  is  the  kingdom,  The  power 
and  the  glory,  For  ever  and  ever.     Amen. 

Here  and  was  never  inserted  before  The 
power. 

In  the  revised  version  of  the  New  Testa- 
ment the  last  paragraph  before  the  doxology 
is  changed  into  "  deliver  us  from  the  evil 
one."  And  the  doxology  is  only  given  in 
the  margin.  See  Canon  Cook's  pamphlet 
entitled  ".Deliver  us  from  Evil,"  defending 
the  old  translation  and  the  doxology. 

LORD'S  SUPPER.  A  name  for  the 
sacrament  of  the  Holy  Eucharist.  1.  The 
name  occurs  in  1  Cor.  xi.  20 ;  but  in 
that  passage  it  is  generally  supposed  by 
commentators,  that  reference  is  made  to  the 
love-feast,  kept  in  imitation  of  our  Lord's 
last  supper, ,  which  was  previous  to  the 
original  Eucharist.  It  seems  probable  that 
the  whole  rite,  agape  or  love-feast,  and 
Holy  Communion,  was  called  the  ".Lord's 
Supper.",  This  may  be  gathered  from  Igna- 
tius' epistle  to  Smyrna  (c.  8),  and  from 
Tertulhan  (Apol.  59),  and  from  other  fathers. 
That  the  two  were  combined  under  the  one 
term  "  Lord's  Supper,"  is  also  evident  from 
a  canon  of  the  Council  of  Carthage  (a.d. 
397),  by  which  it  is  decreed  that  the 
"  sacrament  of  the  Altar  shall  be  celebrated 
only  by  men  fasting  except  on  that  one 
day  (i.e.  Thursday  before  Easter)  on  which 
the  Lord's  Supper  is  celebrated."  St.  Augus- 
tine   uses   the   term  "Casna  Domini"    Ir 


LORD'S  TABLE 

association  both  with  the  love-feast,  or  agape, 
and  the  Eucharist  (Letter  cxviii.).  "This 
much,"  saj's  Dr.  Waterland,  summing  up 
the  matter,  "  is  certain,  that  in  the  apostoU- 
cal  times  the  love-feast  and  the  Eucharist, 
though  distinct,  went  together,  and  were 
nearly  allied  to  each  other,  and  were 
both  of  them  celebrated  at  one  meeting. 
Afterwards  when  the  agapaj  were  done 
away  with,  the  especial  service  of  the 
Eucharist  often  retained  the  name  of  the 
'  Lord's  Supper ' "  (See  Agapss). 

II.  The  term  Ciena  Domini  is  used  in 
the  Confession  of  Augsburg,  and  was  adopted 
by  Calvin,  probably  as  a  safe  word  to  be 
used  mstead  of  "  Mass  "  (Instit.  iv.  22).  The 
first  Act  of  Parhament  .in  the  reign  of 
Edward  VI.  (a.d.  1547)  speaks  of  the  sacra- 
ment as  "  commonly  called  the  Sacrament 
of  the  Altar,  and  in  Scripture  the  Supper, 
and  Table  of  the  Lord,  the  communion  and 
partaking  of  the  Body  and  Blood  of  Christ." 
In  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549  the  title  of 
the  ofBce  is  "  The  Supper  of  the  Lord,  and 
the  Holy  Communion,  commonly  called  the 
Mass  " :  in  1552  it  was  "  The  order  for  the 
administration  of  the  Lord's  Supper,  or  Holy 
Communion  (See  Eiicharist ;  Holy  Gom- 
munion).     [H.] 

LORD'S  TABLE.  One  of  the  names 
given  to  the  altar  in  Christian  Churches. 
The  term  im.plies  the  idea  of  communion  in 
the  Holy  rite — a  table  provided  by  God  in 
the-  wilderness  at  which  all  may  meet  to- 
gether and  be  fed  (Ps.  Ixxviii.  19).  Thus 
Bishop  Andrewes  says,  "  it  is  fitly  called  a 
table,  the  Eucharist  being  considered  as  a 
sacrament."  The  "  Holy  Table,"  or  "  Com- 
munion Table,"  is  the  le°al  term  in  our 
Church,  as  was  decided  in  the  case  Faulkner 
V.  Lichfield  (1  Robertson,  184),  and  also  in 
Parker  v.  Leach  (L.  R.  1  P.  C.  312)  (See 
Altar:  Mensa).     [H.] 

LOUD  VOICE.  A  term  in  our  hturgy 
which  may  be  considered  technical ;  as  not 
merely  meaning  audible  (though  this  ex- 
pression is  also  used),-  but  as  being  a  contra- 
distinction to  the  seer etb  of  the  unreformed 
service,  and  the  mystic  voice  (^fiva-TiKws)  of 
the  Greek  Church  :;  certain  prayers-and  part 
of  the  service-  having  been  repeated  in  an 
inaudible  whisper  (See  Lord^s  Prayer). 

LOVErFEASTS. .  {^ee  Agapss.')  ;. Feasts 
held  in  the  apostolic  ag?'  before  .the-  cele- 
bration of  the  Eucharist,  and  discontinued  on 
account  of  the  abuse  of  them.    . 

LOVE,  THE  FAMILY  OF.:  A  sect  of 
enthusiasts,-  which  arose  in  Holland,  and 
being  propagated  across  the-  Channel,  -  ap- 
peared in  England  about  the  year  1580. 

These  sectaries  pretended  to  a  more  than 
ordinary  sanctity,,  which  gained  upon  the 
affections  of  the  common  people.  They 
affirmed,  that  none  were  of  the  number  of 


LUCIFERIANS 


405- 


the  elect,  but  such  as  were  admitted  into 
their  family,  and  that  all  the  rest  were 
reprobate,  and  consign  od  over  to  eternal 
damnation.  They  held,  hkewise,  that  it 
was  lawful  for  them  to  swear  to  an  untruth 
before  a  magistrate,  for  their  own  con- 
venience, or  before  any  person,  who  was 
not  of  their  society.  In  order  to  propagate 
their  opinions,  they  dispersed  books,  trans- 
lated out  of  Dutch  into  English,  entitled. 
The  Oospd  of  the  Kingdom.  Documental 
Sentences.  The  Prophecy  of  the  Spirit  of 
Love.  The  Publishing  of  Peace  upon  Earth, 
&c. 

These  Familists  could  by  no  means  be 
prevailed  upon  to  discover  their  author: 
nevertheless  it  was  afterwards  found  to  be- 
Henry  Nicholas  of  Leyden,  who  pretended 
that  he  partook  of  the  Di-vinity  of  God,  and 
God  of  his  humanity.  Queen  Elizabeth 
issued  a  proclamation  against  these  sectaries, 
and  ordered  their  books  to  be  publicly 
burnt. 

LOW  SUNDAY:  the  Sunday  after 
Easter.  In  the  Sacramentary  of  Gregory, 
all  the  days  between  Easter  and  its  octave 
have  "in  Albis"  added  to  them.  The 
Sunday,  however,  was  called  "  Dominica 
octavas  Pascha3."  It  was  also  called  (in  the 
Ambrosian  Missal)." Dominica  in  albis  de- 
positis,"  because  on  this  day  the  newly 
baptized  on  Easter  eve  laid  aside  their 
white  robes  or  chrisoms;  and  hence  the- 
Sunday  was  called,  for  short,  "  Dominica  in 
albis."  The  English  name  "  Low  Sunday  "' 
may  have  its  origin  from  the  contrast 
between  the  joyous  services  of  Easter,  and 
the  return  to  the  ordinary  Sunday  service. 
But.  it  would  seem  more  probable  that 
"Low"  is  a  corruption  of  "Laudes";  for 
the  first  words  of  the  sequence  for  the  day 
were  "  Laudes  Salvatori  voce  modulemur 
supplici."  It  would  therefore  very  naturally 
be  called  the  "  Laudes "  Sunday ;  and, 
corrupted, ."  Low  Sunday."     [H.] 

LUCIAN:  Priest  and  Martyr:  commemo- 
rated in  our  Calendar  Jan.  8.  He  was  sent 
by  Fabian,  bishop  of  Rome,  on  a  mission  to 
Gaul  with  SS.  Denys  and  Quentin.  He  i& 
said  to  have  become  bishop  of  Beauvais,  and 
to  have  suffered  martyrdom  in  290.     [H.] 

LUCIFERIANS,  in  ecclesiastical  an- 
tiquity, ris  the  name  of  those  Christians, 
who  followed  Lucifer,  bishop  of  Cagliari', 
the  (iapital  of  Sardinia. 

Lucifer  lived  in  the  fourth  century,  and  ■ 
was  famous  for  his  extraordinary  virtues 
and  abilities.  He  was  one  of  those  banished 
by  Coiistantius  for  their  defence  of  Atha- 
nasius,  and  staunch  opposition  to  the  Arians. 
In  his  banishment  he  wrote  several  books 
or  pamphlets,  two-  "  pro  sanoto  Athanasio," 
and  several  very  violent  ones  against  Con- 
staatius.    He  was  recalled  from  his  exile 


464 


LUCY 


by  the  emperor  Julian,  ia  361,  wten, 
coming  to  Antioch,  where  the  Church  was 
extremely  divided  between  the  followers  of 
Euzoius  the  Arian,  and  of  Meletius  and 
Eustathius,  orthodox  bishops,  he,  to  put  an 
•end  to  the  schism,  ordained  Paulinus  bishop, 
whom  neither  of  the  orthodox  parties  ap- 
proved. Eusebius  of  Vercelli,  whom  the 
Council  of  Alexandria  had  sent  to  heal  the 
divisions,  extremely  disapproved  this  ordina- 
tion; whereupon  Lucifer,  who  would  have 
nothing  to  do  with  conciliation,  broke  off 
communion  with  him  and  the  other  prelates, 
and  retired  to  Sardinia,  where,  it  would 
seem,  he  continued  to  occupy  his  see.  How 
far  he  and  his  followers  were  schismatic  is 
uncertain.  They  did  not  apparently  hold 
erroneous  doctrines  (the  account  in  St. 
Aug.  de  Ilxres.  c.  81,  being  very  doubtful), 
but  had  scruples  of  conscience  as  to  the 
restoration  of  communion  to  such  as  had 
been  Arians  through  ignorance  or  weakness. 
Though  St.  Augustine  speaks  of  Lucifer 
as  "  fallen  into  the  darkness  of  schism " 
(^Ep.  185),  St.  Jerome  describes  him  as 
•"beatus  pastor"  {Adv.  Lucif.  sec.  20). 
Lucifer  died  a.d.  371. — Newman's  Fleury, 
xviii.  20 ;  Diet.  OJirist.  Biog.     [H.] 

LUCY :  Virgin  and  Martyr :  commemo- 
rated on  December  13.  She  suffered  martyr- 
dom in  the  Diocletian  persecution,  being 
tortured  to  death  by  fire  and  red-hot  pincers, 
and  she  is  represented  as  bearing  a  dish  on 
which  are  two  eyeballs  and  two  pincers. 
Though  she  was  regarded  as  patroness 
against  eye-diseases,  there  is  no  mention  in 
the  early  legends  of  the  loss  of  her  eyes; 
.the  idea  probably  arising  from  her  name 
Lucia — ^lux — light. — Bed.  Mart. ;  E.  Daniel's 
F.  B ';  Diet.  Christ.  Biog.     [H.] 

LUKE,  ST.,  THE  EVANGELIST'S 
DAY.  A  festival  of  the  Christian  Church, 
observed  on  the  18th  of  October. 

St.  Luke  is  supposed  to  have  been  born 
at  Antioch,  and  to  have  been  a  physician 
■and  a  painter;  but  the  latter  seems  very 
doubtful  (Eusebius,  Hist.  iii.  4 ;  Niceph.  ii. 
43).  It  is  not  agreed  whether  he  was,  by 
birth,  a  Jew,  or  a  heathen.  Epiphanius 
(cont.  Hser.  li.  11),  who  makes  him  to  be 
one  of  the  seventy  disciples,  and  consequently 
a  Jew,  thinks  he  was  one  of  those  who  left 
Jesus  Christ  upon  hearing  these .  words, 
."  He  who  eateth  not  my  flesh,  and  drinketh 
not  my  blood,  is  not  worthy  of  me ; "  but 
that  he  returned  to  the  faith  upon  hearing 
St.  Paul's  sermons  at  Antioch.  Some 
authors,  suppose  he  was  Cleopas'  companion, 
and  went  with  him  to  Emmaus,  when 
Jesus  Christ  joined  them. 

St.  Luke  accompanied  St.  Paul  in  his 
several  journeys;  lout  at  what  time  they 
first  came  together  is  uncertain.  Some 
4hink  he  met  St.  Paul  at  Antioch,  and  from 


LUTHERANS 

that  time  never  forsook  him.  Others  believe 
they  met  at  Troas,  because  St.  Luke  hun- 
self  says,  "  immediately  we  endeavoured  to 
go  into  Macedonia,  from  Troas." 

Some  think  he  survived  St.  Paul  many 
years,  and  that  he  died  at  eighty-four  years 
of  age  :  but  where,  authors  are  not  agreed. 
Achaia,  Thebes  in  BtEotia,  Elea  in  the 
Peloponnesus,  Ephesus,  and  Bithynia,  are 
severally  named  as  the  place  of  his  death. 
Nor  are  authors  better  agreed  as  to  the 
manner  of  it.  Some  believe  he  suffered 
martyrdom ;  and  the  modern  Greeks  affimi 
he  was  crucified  on  an  olive-tree.  Others, 
on  the  contrary,  and  among  them  many  of 
the  modems,  think  he  died  a  natural  death. 

LUKE'S,  ST.,  GOSPEL.  A  canonical 
book  of  the  New  Testament.  Some  think 
it  was  properly  St.  Paul's  Gospel,  and  that 
when  St.  Paul  speaks  of  his  Gospel,  he 
means  what  is  called  St.  Luke's  Gospel. 
Irenseus  says  only,  that  St.  Luke  digested 
into  writing  what  St.  Paul  preached  to  the 
Gentiles;  and  others  assert  that  St.  Luke 
wrote  with  the  assistance  of  St.  Paul. — 
Iren.  cont.  Hear.  iii.  1 ;  Euseb.  E.  Hist. 
vi.  25 ;  Tertull.  cont.  Marc.  iv.  5. 

This  evangelist  addresses  his  Gospel,  and 
the  Acts  of  the  Apostles,  to  one  Theophilus, 
of  whom  we  have  no  knowledge ;  many  of 
the  ancients  have  taken  this  name,  in  an 
appellative  sense,  for  any  one  who  loves  God 
(See  Alford's  Glc.  Test,  proleg.  c.  iv.). 

LUTHERANS.  Those  Christians  who 
follow  the  opinions  of  Martin  Luther. 

I.  In  the  beginning  of  the  16th  century, 
the  state  of  tho  Church  was  such  that  it  was 
evident  that  reformation  could  not  long  be 
delayed.  The  immoralities  of  Pope  Alex- 
ander II. ;  the  indifference  of  Julius  II.;  the 
infidelity,  scarcely  disguised,  of  Leo  X. ; 
together  with  the  corruption  which  tamted 
all  orders  from  the  prelates  to  the  lower 
clergy,  had  brought  the  professors  of  religion 
into  the  lowest  repute :  whUe  amongst  all, 
clergy  and  laity,  the  state  of  morals  was 
something  terrible,  and  the  revival  of 
learning  assimilating  itself  to  the  revival  of 
heathendom.  The  last  abuse  which  precipi- 
tated the  reformation  on  the  continent,  was 
the  granting  indulgences  (see  Indulgences), 
by  Pope  Leo  X.,  to  those  who  contributed 
towards  the  finishing  St.  Peter's  church  at 
Rome.  It  i3  said,  the  pope  at  first  gave  the 
princess  Cibo,  his  sister,  that  branch  of  the 
revenue  of  indulgences  which  were  collected 
in  Saxony ;  that  afterwards  these  indul- 
gences were  farmed  out  to  those  who  would 
give  most  for  them;  and  that  these  pur- 
chasers, to  make  the  most  of  their  bargain, 
pitched  upon  such  preachers,  receivers,  and 
collectors  of  indulgences,  as  they  thought 
proper  for  their  purpose,  who  managed  their 
business  in  a  scandalous  maimer.     The  pope 


LDTHEEANS 

had  sent  these  indulgences  to  Prince  Albert, 
archbishop  of  Mainz  and  brother  to  the 
Elector  of  Brandenburg,  to  publish  them  in 
German}'.  This  prelate  put  his  commission 
into  the  hands  of  John  Tetzel,  a  Dominican, 
and  an  inquisitor,  who  employed  several  of 
his  own  order  to  preach  up  and  recommend 
these  indulgences  to  the  people.  These 
Dominicans  managed  the  matter  so  well, 
that  the  people  eagerly  bought  up  all  the 
indulgences.  And  the  farmers,  finding 
money  come  in  very  plentifully,  spent  it 
publicly  in  a  luxurious  and  libertine  manner. 

John  Staupitz,  vicar-general  of  the 
Augustines  in  Germany,  was  the  first  who 
took  occasion  to  declare  against  these 
abuses ;  for  which  purpose  he  made  use  of 
Martin  Luther,  the  most  learned  of  all  the 
Augustines.  He  was  a  native  of  Eisleben, 
a  town  of  the  county  of  Mansfeld,  in 
Saxony;  and  he  taught  divinity  at  the 
university  of  Wittemberg.  This  learned 
Augustine  mounted  the  pulpit,  and  de- 
claimed vehemently  against  the  abuse  of 
indulgences.  Nor  did  he  stop  here ;  he 
fixed  ninety-five  propositions  upon  the 
church  doors  of  Wittemberg,  not  as  dog- 
matical points  which  he  himself  held,  but 
in  order  to  be  considered  and  examined  in 
a  public  conference.  John  Tetzel,  the 
Dominican,  immediately  published  ~  106 
propositions  against  them,  at  Frankfort 
upon  the  Oder ;  and,  by  virtue  of  the  office 
of  inquisitor,  ordered  those  of  Luther  to  be 
burnt;  whose  adherents,  to  revenge  the 
afiront  offered  to  Luther,  publicly  burnt 
those  of  Tetzel  at  Wittemberg.  Thus  war 
was  declared  between  the  Dominicans  and 
Augustines,  and  soon  after  between  the 
Roman  Catholics  and  the  Lutheran  party, 
which  from  that  time  began  to  appear  openly 
against  the  Western  Church. 

In  the  year  1518,  Eckius,  professor  of 
divinity  at  Ingolstadt,  and  Silvester  Prierius, 
a  Dominican,  and  master  of  the  sacred 
palace,  wrote  against  Luther's  TJieses,  who 
answered  them  in  a  tract,  which  he  sent  to 
the  pope  and  the  bishop  of  Brandenburg,  his 
diocesan,  offering  to  submit  to  the  Holy  See 
in  the  points  contested.  But  Prierius  hav- 
ing published  a  discourse  full  of  extravagant 
amplifications  of  the  pope's  power,  Luther 
took  occasion  from  thence  to  make  the  papal 
authority  appear  odious  to  the  Germans.  In 
the  meantime,  the  process  against  Luther 
going  on  at  Rome,  the  pope  summoned  him 
to  appear  there  within  sixty  days :  but,  at 
the  instance  of  the  duke  of  Saxony,  his 
Holiness  consented  that  the  cause  should  be 
examined  in  Germany,  and  delegated  his 
legate.  Cardinal  Cajetan,  to  try  it.  This 
cardinal  gave  Luther  a  peremptory  order  to 
recant,  and  not  to  appear  any  more  before 
him  unless  he  complied ;  upon  which  Luther, 


LUTHERANS 


465 


in  the  night-time,  posted  up  an  appeal 
to  the  pope,  and  retired  to  Wittemberg. 
Afterwards,  fearing  he  should  be  condemned 
at  Rome,  he  published  a  protestation  in 
form  of  law,  and  appealed  to  a  general 
council. 

In  the  beginning  of  the  next  year,  1519, 
the  emperor  Maximilian  dying,  and  the 
Elector  of  Saxony,  who  protected  Luther, 
being  vicar  of  the  empire  during  the  inter- 
regnum, that  reformer's  interest  and  cha- 
racter were  greatly  raised,  and  he  was 
generally  looked  upon  as  a  man  sent  from 
God  to  correct  the  abuses  which  had  crept 
into  the  Roman  Church.  In  June,  the  same 
year,  there  was  a  famous  conference  between 
Luther,  Eckius,  and  Carolostadius,  at  Leip- 
sio;  in  which  they  agreed  to  refer  them- 
selves to  the  universities  of  Erfurt  and  Paris. 
The  points  debated  upon  were,  free-will, 
purgatory,  indulgences,  penance,  and  the 
pope's  supremacy. 

In  1520,  Luther  sent  his  book  De  Li- 
bertate  Christiana  to  the  pope ;  in  which 
he  grounds  justification  upon  faith  alone, 
without  the  assistance  of  good  works ;  and 
asserts,  that  Christian  liberty  rescues  us 
from  the  bondage  of  human  traditions,  and 
particularly  the  slavery  of  papal  impositions. 
Afterwards,  in  a  remonstrance  written  in 
High  Dutch,  he  proceeded  to  deny  the 
authority  of  the  Church  of  Rome. 

In  June  the  same  year,  the  pope  resolved 
to  apply  the  last  remedies  which  the  Church 
makes  use  of  against  her  enemies,  and 
began  with  condemning  in  writing  forty-one 
propositions  extracted  from  Luther's  writ- 
ings, giving  him  sixty  days  to  recant :  but 
Luther  refusing  to  comply,  the  pope  declared 
him  excommunicated,  and  sent  the  bull  by 
Eckius  to  the  Elector  of  Saxony  and  the 
university  of  Wittemberg,  who  agreed  to 
defer  the  publication  of  it.  In  the  mean- 
time Luther  wrote  against  the  bull  with 
great  warmth  and  freedom,  and  appealed 
once  more  from  the  pope  to  a  general 
council.  Besides  which,  he  caused  a  large 
bonfire  to  be  made  without  the  walls  of 
Wittemberg,  and  threw  into  it  with  his  own 
hands  the  pope's  bull,  together  with  the 
decretalSj  extravagants,  and  Clementines. 
This  example  was  followed  by  his  disciples 
in  several  other  toA^ms. 

The  emperor  Charles  V.  declared  against 
Luther,  and  ordered  his  books  to  be  burnt. 
Upon  the  opening  of  the  Diet  of  Worms, 
in  1521,  Luther,  with  the  emperor's  per- 
mission, appeared  there,  and  made  a  speech 
in  defence  of  himself  and  his  opinions. 
But,  when  the  diet  found  that  he  would 
neither  stand  to  the  decisions  of  councils 
nor  the  decrees  of  popes,  the  emperor  gave 
him  twenty  days  to  retire  to  a  place  of 
security,  and,  a  month  after   published  his 

2  H 


46G 


LUTHERANS 


imperial  edict,  by  wkich  Luther  was  put 
under  the  ban  of  the  empire,  as  an  heretic 
and  schismatic.  But  the  duke  of  Saxony 
gave  private  orders  to  convey  Luther  to 
the  castle  of  Wartburg,  where  he  was  con- 
cealed three-quarters  of  a  year.  He  worked 
hard  in  this  retirement,  which  he  called  his 
Isle  of  Patmos,  and  kept  up  the  spirit  of  his 
party  by  writing  new  books ;  amon:;  which 
were  his  "  Tracts  "  against  auricular  con- 
fession, private  masses,  monastic  vowS,  and 
the  celibacy  of  the  clergy.  About  this  time 
the  nniversity  of  Paris,  to  which  he  had 
appealed,  condemned  a  hundred  proposi- 
tions extracted  out  of  his  books  ;  and  King 
Henry  VIH.  of  England  wrote  against  him 
in  defence  of  the  seven  sacraments.  Luther 
replied  both  to  the  Sorbonne  and  to  the  king 
of  England,  but  in  a  very  rude  and  un- 
mannerly way. 

Soon  after  he  broke  out  of  his  retirement, 
and  was  so  hardy  as  to  publish  a  bull 
against  the  pope's  bull  In  cmna  Domini, 
calling  it  the  Bull  and  Reformation  of  Doctor 
Luther.  About  this  time  he  published  part 
of  his  translation  of  the  Bible,  in  which  he 
departed  from  the  Vulgate,  so  long  author- 
ised and  received  by  the  Church. 

The  Elector  of  Saxony,  who  all  along 
favoured  and  protected  Luther,  now  gave 
him  leave  to  reform  the  Churches  of  Wir- 
temberg  as  he  thought  fit.  The  reformer 
proposed  likewise  a  regulation  concerning 
the  patrimony  of  the  Church;  which  was, 
that  the  bishops,  abbots,  and  monks  should 
be  expelled,  and  all  the  lands  and  revenues 
of  the  bishoprics,  abbeys,  aM  monasteries, 
should  escheat  to  the  respective  princes ; 
and  that  all  the  convents  of  Mendicant 
friars  should  be  turned  into  public  schools 
or  hospitals.  This  project  pleased  the 
princes  and  magistrates,  who  began  to 
rehsh  Luther's  doctrine  extremelvj  inso- 
much that,  at  the  Diet  of  WarteMcrg''  in 
1523,  when  Pope  Adrian  VI.  insisted  upon 
the  bull  of  Leo  X.  and  the  Edict  of  Worms 
against  Luther,  he  could  not  prevail  with 
the  princes  to  put  them  in  execution,  but 
■was  answered,  that  a  general  council  ought 
to  be  called,  and  that  there  ought  to  be  a 
reformation  of  the  ecclesiastics,  and  espe- 
cially of  the  Court  of  Rome.  This  year, 
Luther  had  the  satisfaction  to  see  a  league 
contracted  between  Gustavus,  king  of 
Sweden,  and  Frederick,  king  of  Denmark, 
who  both  agreed  to  establish  Lutheranism 
in  their  dominions.  And  now  Luther's 
persuasion,  which,  from  the  Upper  Saxony, 
had  spread  itself  into  the  northern  provinces, 
began  to  be  perfectly  settled  in  the  duchies 
of  Lunenburg,  Brunswicxi;,  Mecklenburg,  and 
Pomerania;  and  in  the  archbishoprics  of 
Magdeburg  and  Bremen ;  and  in  the  towns 
of  Hamburg,   Wismar,    Rostock ;   and    all 


LUTHERANS 

along  the  Baltic,  as  far  as  Livonia  and 
Prussia. 

About  this  time  Luther  left  off  the  habit 
of  a  monk,  and  dressed  himself  like  a  doctor, 
refusing  to  be  saluted  with  the  title  of 
reverend  father.  Erasmus  having  written  a 
book  concerning  free-will  (De  Libera  Ar- 
bitrio),  Luther  answered  it  in  another,  en- 
titled De  Servo  Arbitrio.  In  1525,  Thomas 
Miinzer  and  Nicholas  Store,  taking  their 
leave  of  Luther,  put  themselves  at  the  head 
of  the  Anabaptist'^  and  Fanatics.  About  this 
time  Luther  married  a  nun,  called  Catharine 
Boren,  exhorting  all  the  ecclesiastics  and 
monks  to  follow  his  example.  In  1526, 
Philip,  Landgrave  of  Hesse,  turned  Luthe- 
ran, who  gave  great  Ufe  and  spirit  to  that 
party. 

In  March,  1529,  the  Diet  of  Spire  de- 
creed that  the  Catholics  should  not  have 
the  liberty  to  change  their  religion;  that 
the  Lutherans  should  be  tolerated  till  the 
meeting  of  a  council,  but  not  allowed  to 
molest  the  Catholics ;  and  that  the  preach- 
ers should  deliver  nothing  in  their  sennons 
contrary  to  the  received  doctrines  of  the 
Church.  The  Lutheran  princes  entered  a 
solemn  protestation  against  this  decree, 
from  whence  came  the  name  of  Protestants, 
taken  up  first  by  the  Lutherans,  and  after- 
wards received  among  the  Calvinists. 

The  beginning  of  October,  this  year,  was 
held  at  Marburg  the  conference  between 
Luther  and  Zwinglius,  in  relation  to  the 
Eucharist ;  the  latter  affirming  that  there  is 
nothing  more  than  bread  and  wine  in  the 
Lord's  supper,  which  elements  are  the  figure 
and  representation  of  Christ's  body  and 
blood ;  and  Luther  asserting  that  His  hod}'' 
and  blood  are  really  present,  but  under  the 
substance  of  bread  and  wine,  and  that  onlj' 
in  the  act  of  receiving  the  sacrament ;  after 
which  he  did  not  acknowledge  the  continu- 
ance of  this  presence.  This  conference 
broke  up  without  coming  to  any  accommo- 
dation. 

In  1530,  the  Lutherans  or  Protestants 
drew  up  a  Confession  of  Faith,  which  they 
presented  to  the  Diet  of  Augsburg  (See 
Augsburg,  Confession  of).  ^ 

The  year  after,  the  Protestant  princes 
made  the  famous  league  of  Smalcalde,  which 
obliged  the  emperor  to  grant  the  Lutherans 
a  toleration,  till  the  differences  in  religion 
were  settled  by  a  council,  which  he  engaged 
himself  to  call  in  six  months. 

The  Lutheran  party  gaining  strength 
every  day,  and  having  refused  the  bull  for 
convening  a  council  at  Mantua,  the  emperor 
summoned  a  general  diet  at  Ratisbon,  where 
a  scheme  of  religion  for  reconciling  the  two 
parties  was  examined :  but,  after  they  had 
examined  and  disputed  for  a  month  together, 
the  divines  could  agree  upon  no  more  than 


LUTHERANS 

five  or  six  articles,  concerning  justification, 
free-will,  original  sin,  ba]jtism,  good  works, 
and  episcopacy ;  for,  when  they  came  to 
•other  points,  and  especially  the  Eucharist, 
the  Lutherans  would  by  no  means  yield  to 
the  other  party.  The  diet  ended  with  a 
decree  of  the  emperor,  strictly  forbidding 
the  Lutherans  to  tamper  with  any  person  to 
make  them  quit  their  old  religion,  and  at 
the  same  time  suspending  all  the  edicts 
published  against  them. 

Martin  Luther  lived  to  see  the  opening  of 
the  famous  Council  of  Trent,  for  accommo- 
dating the  differences  in  religion ;  which 
put  him  upon  acting  with  more  vigour  and 
warmth  against  the  Church  of  Home,  as 
foreseeing  that  his  opinions  would  be  con- 
demned there.  In  short,  he  left  no  stone 
unturned  to  engage  the  Protestant  princes  to 
Act  against  the  council ;  which  measures  he 
■continued  to  pursue  until  his  death,  which 
happened  in  February,  1546. 

Maurice,  the  Elector  of  Saxony,  having 
"taken  the  field  against  the  emiDeror,  and 
•concluded  a  peace  with  him  at  Passau,  in 
1552,  it  was  stipulated  that  the  exercise  of 
Lutheranism,  as  stated  by  the  Confession 
•of  Augsburg,  should  be  tolerated  all  over 
"the  empire ;  which  toleration  was  to  last 
for  ever,  in  case  the  difi'erences  in  religion 
•could  not  be  accommodated  within  six 
months.  And  thus  Lutheranism  was  per- 
fectly settled  in  Germany. 

The  electors  and  kings  of  Prussia  have 
from  time  to  time  endeavoured  to  bring 
about  a  union  between  Lutheranism  and 
Calvinism.  In  1817  the  King  of  Prussia 
formed  out  of  both  communities  in  his 
-dominions  one  "  Evangelical  Christian 
■Church";  the  names  Protestant  and  Re- 
formed being  abolished.  In  1822  a  new 
Liturgy  was  drawn  up,  and  accei^ted  by 
most  of  the  congregations.  Those  who  did 
not  accept,  or  old  Lutherans,  as  they  were 
■called,  were  for  some  time  persecuted,  and 
many  fled  to  America.  They  are  now,  how- 
ever, recognised  by  law. 

The  Lutherans  have  been  generally 
•divided  into  the  moderate  and  the  rigid. 
The  moderate  Lutherans  are  those  who  sub- 
mitted to  the  Interim,  published  by  the 
emperor  Charles  V.  Melanchthon  was  the 
head  of  this  party  (See  Interim). 

The  rigid  Lutlierans  are  those  who  would 
not  endure  any  alteration  in  any  of  Luther's 
-opinions.  The  head  of  this  party  was 
Matthias  Flacius,  famous  for  writing  the 
Centuries  of  MagdAurg,  in  which  he  had 
three  other  Lutheran  ministers  for  his 
assistants. 

To  these  are  added  another  division, 
-called  Luthero-Zwinglians,  because  they  held 
-some  of  Luthei''s  tenets  and  some  of 
-Zwinglius',  yielding  something  to  each  side. 


LUTHEEANS 


4G7 


to  prevent  the  ill  consequence  of  disunion 
in  the  Beformation. 

The  old  Lutherans  retain  the  use  of  the 
altar  for  the  celebration  of  the  Holy  Com- 
munion, some  of  the  ancient  vestments,  and 
they  likewise  make  use  of  lighted  tapers  in 
their  churches,  of  incense,  and  a  crucifix  on 
the  altar,  of  the  sign  of  the  cross,  and  of 
images,  &o.  Several  of  their  doctors  ac- 
knowledge that  such  materials  add  a  lustre 
and  majesty  to  Divine  worship,  and  fix  at 
the  same  time  the  attention  of  the  people. 

The  Lutherans  retained  the  observance  of 
several  solemn  festivals  after  their  reforma- 
tion. They  keep  three  solemn  days  of 
festivity  at  Christmas.  In  some  Lutheran 
countries,  the  people  go  to  church  on  the 
night  of  the  nativity  of  our  Blessed  Saviour 
with  lighted  candles  or  wax  tapers  in  their 
hands;  and  the  faithful,  who  meet  in  the 
church,  spend  the  whole  night  tiiere  in 
singing  and  saying  their  prayers  by  the 
light  of  them.  Sometimes  they  bum  such 
a  large  quantity  of  incense,  that  the  smoke 
of  it  ascends  like  a  whirlwind,  and  their 
devotees  may  properly  enough  be  said  to 
be  wrapped  up  in  it.  It  is  customary, 
likewise,  in  Germany,  to  give  entertain- 
ments at  such  times  to  friends  and  rela- 
tions, and  to  send  presents  to  each  other, 
especially  to  the  young  people,  whom  they 
amuse  with  romantic  stories,  telling  them 
that  our  Blessed  Saviour  descends  from 
heaven  on  the  night  of  His  nativity,  and 
brings  with  Him  all  kinds  of  playthings. 

They  have  three  holidays  at  Easter,  and 
three  at  Whitsuntide,  as  well  as  those 
before  mentioned  at  Christmas.  The  other 
festivals  observed  by  the  Lutherans  are. 
New  Year's  Day,  or  the  Circumcision,  a 
festival  not  near  so  ancient  as  the  three 
above  mentioned ;  the  festival  of  the  Three 
Kings,  or,  otherwise,  the  Epiphany ;  the 
Purification  of  the  Blessed  Virgin,  or  Candle- 
mas ;  and  Lady  Day,  or  the  Annunciation. 
There  is  no  public  work  nor  service  devoted 
to  the  Blessed  A''irgin,  nor  'are  there  any 
processions,  or  other  ceremonies,  which  are 
observed  by  the  Roman  Catholics  on  the 
two  latter  festivals.  The  festival  of  tlie 
Sacred  Trinity  is  solemnized  on  the  Sunda}' 
after  Whitsunday  ;  that  of  St  John  Baptist, 
on  the  24th  of  June  ;  and  that  of  the  Visi- 
tation of  the  Blessed  Virgin,  on  the  2nd  of 
July,  as  it  is  by  the  Roman  Catholics.  The 
festival  of  St.  Michael  the  Archangel,  or 
rather  the  ceremonies  observed  by  the 
Lutherans  on  that  day,  are  the  remains 
only  of  an  ancient  custom,  which  has  been 
preserved  amongst  them,  although  some- 
what extraordinary,  as  the  members  of 
their  communion  retain  no  manner  of  vene- 
ration for  angels.  Burnet's  Hist.  Reform,  i. 
60,     &c. ;     Loesoher's     Hist.    Mot.     inter 

2  H  2 


468 


LYCH-GATE 


Lutheranos  et  Refoi'matos,  pt.  i.  c.  ii. ; 
Waddington's  Hist,  of  Reformation ;  Tul- 
lock's  Luther  (1883). 

LYCH-GATE,  or  COEPSE-GATE. 
From  leich,  "a  dead  body" — (lience Leitch- 
field).  A  gate  at  the  entrance  of  the  churoli- 
yard,  where  the  body  is  placed  before 
burial.  These  are  of  freqrient  occurrence  in 
ancient  churchyards. 

LYCHNOSCOPE.  A  narrow  window 
near  the  ground,  very  frequently  found  at 
the  south-west  end  of  a  chancel,  not  in- 
frequently at  the  north-west,  and  sometimes, 
though  seldom,  in  other  parts  of  the  church. 

The  theory  that  lychnoscopes  were  confes- 
sionals is  erroneous.  There  is  no  authority 
whatever  for  supposing  that  a  confessional 
ever  formed  a  structural  part  of  a  church 
in  this  or  any  other  country.  There  can  be 
no  doubt  that  lychnoscopes  were  made  to 
allow  a  view  of  the  high  altar,  or  some 
other  altar  at  the  time  of  the  Elevation  of 
the  Host ;  not  unfrequently  to  enable  the 
sacristan  to  ring  the  bell  at  the  right  moment. 
Slits  or  loopholes  in  the  lower  part  of  a 
church  wall  were  sometimes  for  ventilation  ; 
sometimes  for  lepers  to  take  part  in  the 
service  from  outside. — Mr.  Lowe  in  Transac- 
tions of  the  Northamptonshire,  Lincolnshire, 
and  other  Architectural  Societies,  vol.  i. 


M. 

MACCABEES.     Two  books  in  the  Apo- 
crypha, which  relate  the  exploits  of  Judas 
Maccabeus  and  his    brethren.      The  first 
book,  which  is  a  valuable   and  authentic 
history,  contains  the  history  of  the  Jews 
from  the  beginning  of  the  reign  of  Antiochus 
Bpiphanes  to  the  death  of  Simon,  a  period 
of  about  thirty-four   years.      The    second 
book  contains  the  history  of  about  fifteen 
years,  a.m.  3828  to  3843,  from  the  commis- 
sion of  Heliodorus  to  pillage  the  temple,  to 
the  victory  of  Judas  Maccabeus  over  Nicanor. 
These  two  books  are  accounted  canonical 
by  the  Boman  Catholics.    There  are  besides 
two  other  books,  called  the  third  &-aA  fourth 
books  of  Maccabees,  of  very  little  authority, 
and  which  were  never  admitted  into   the 
Canon    by    any    Church.      In    the    early 
Christian  Church  the  Maccabees  were  con- 
sidered martyrs,  and  a  festival  was  some- 
times held  in  their  honour.     Several  sermons 
of  the   Fathers  preached  on  this  day  are 
extant. — Gres.  Nazian.  Orat.  2,  de  Maccah. ; 
St.  Chrys.  Horn.  44,   49,  50;   Aug.  Horn. 
109,  110      (See  A^wcrypha,  edited  by  Dr. 
Wace,  1886). 
MACEDONIANS.    So  called  from  Mace- 


MAGNIFIOAT 

donius,  a  bishop  of  Constantinople  A.i^ 
343,  and  also  Pneumatomachi  (mifvim,  /mx^- 
a-Bm),  "  adversaries  of  the  Spirit,"  from  their 
distinctive  error.  A  sect  of  heretics  who- 
denied  the  faith  with  regard  to  the  Holy 
Spirit;  some  denying  His  Divinity,  others 
denying  His  Personality  also.  Macedonius, 
at  first  a  violent  partisan  of  the  Ariaa  faction, 
was  deposed  from  his  see  a.d.  360,  and  it 
was  probably  during  his  retirement  that  he- 
preached  his  heresy.  His  party  became  pro- 
minent after  his  deposition,  when  Athanasius- 
wrote  against  them.  Several  bishops  joined 
him ;  but  they  do  not  appear  to  have  been 
agreed  about  any  positive  doctrine  concern- 
ing the  nature  of  the  Holy  Ghost.  Some 
held,  as  Macedonius  himself  did,  that  He 
was  a  creature ;  others,  that  though  not 
created.  He  is  not  God;  others,  that  the- 
Spirit  was  created  by  the  Son,  and  minis- 
tered to  Him.  The  heresy  was  condemned  ia 
several  synods,  as  that  of  Alexandria  under 
Athanasius,  a.d.  362  ;  that  at  lUyricum  five- 
years  later,  and  at  Home  in  the  same  year  ; 
and  at  Constantinople  in  the  great  council, 
A.D.  381,  when  the  expressions  "  The  Lord, 
the  Lifegiver,"  &c.,  with  the  exception  of 
the  words  "  and  the  Son,"  were  adopted 
from  a  work  of  Epiphanius,  and  approved, 
but  whether  they  were  then  formally 
inserted  in  the  Creed  is  doubtful  (See 
Creed,  Nicene). — Tillemont,  ix.  494r-6  ; 
Hefele,  ii.  10 ;  Soz.  Sec.  S.  iv.  27,  and  vi. 
22 ;  Soc.  ii.  45 ;  Athan.  Synod.  Ep.  ad 
Antioch. ;  Theod.  Jf.  E.  v.  11 ;  Eobertson, 
Oh.  Hist.  i.  274.    [H.] 

MACHUTUS,  Bishop ;  commemorated 
in  our  Calendar  on  November  15.  Bom  in 
Wales,  the  unsettled  state  of  the  country 
compelled  him  to  flee  into  Brittany,  where 
he  led  an  ascetic  life.  He  was  made  bishop 
of  Aleth  in  Brittany  about  a.d.  541 ;  and 
thither  he  returned  to  die,  having  for  a 
time  previous  to  his  death  been  driven  by 
persecution  into  Aquitaine.  He  was  also- 
called  Maclovius,  from  whence  the  name  St. 
Malo,  to  which  the  see  of  Aleth  was  trans- 
ferred, is  derived.    [H.] 

MAGDEBURG      CENTURIES      (See 


MAGNIFICAT.  The  song  of  the  Blessed 
Virgin  Mary,  which  is  appointed  to  be  said, 
or  sung  in  English  after  the  first  lesson  at 
Evening  Prayer. 

This  hymn  was  used  in  the  sei-vices  of  the 
Church  at  a  very  early  period.  In  a.d.  507" 
it  is  found  in  the  office  of  Lauds  in  the  rule 
of  St.  Caasarius  of  Aries  (Mabillon,  de  Cursu 
Oallic.  p.  407),  but  it  was  afterwards 
generally  used  at  vespers,  in  which  service 
it  has  had  its  place  for  at  least  800  years  in 
the  English  Church.  There  are  English 
versions  of  it  of  as  early  a  date  as  the  14th 
century   (MS.   Harlei?n,   2343,   fol.   2,   in 


MALACHI 

the  Brit.  Mus.,  also  in  tbe  Bodleian.  Mas- 
kell,  Mon.  Hit.  iii.  245).  la  the  P.  B.  of 
1552,  the  Cantata  Domino  was  inserted  as 
an  alternative  to  the  Magnificat,  which  was 
■distasteful  to  the  extreme  Reformers  (See 
Cantate). 

MALACHI,  PROPHECY  OF.  A  canon- 
ical book  of  the  Old  Testament.  Malachi 
lived  about  300  B.C.,  and  is  the  last  of  the 
lesser  prophets.  His  death  is  placed  in  the 
Roman  Martyrology  on  Jan.  14.  He  is 
called  by  Tertullian,  Origen,  and  most  of 
the  Fathers,  an  "  angel,"  because  of  his  re- 
puted angelical  mildness. — Speaker's  Com- 
inentary. 
MALO,  ST.  (See  Machutus). 
MANASSES,  PRAYER  OF.  An  Apo- 
cryphal book  of  the  Old  Testament.  It  is 
•considered  spurious  even  by  the  Church  of 
Rome,  and  cannot  be  traced  to  a  higher 
source  than  the  Vulgate  version. 

MAKICH^ANS.       Christian    heretics, 
who    took    their    name    from    Manes,    or 
Manichajus,   as  the   Europeans  wrote  his 
name — Mani  according    to   the   Orientals. 
His  history  is  obscure.     According  to  the 
accounts  given  by  the  Greeks  (from  whom, 
however,  the  Oriental  writers  differ  consider- 
ably), "one  Terebinthus,  disciple  to  Scy- 
thianus,  a  magician,  finding  that  in  Persia, 
whither  he   was  forced  to   retire    out    of 
Palestine,  the  priests  and  learned  men  of 
the  country  did  strongly  oppose  his  errors 
.and  designs,  retired  into  a  widow's  house, 
where  (it  is  said)  he  was  killed,  either  by 
angels  or  by  demons,  as  he  was  engaged  in 
dncantations.     This  woman,   being  heiress 
to  the  money  and  books  of  Terebinthus, 
ibought  a  slave  named  Cubricus,  whom  she 
.afterwards  adopted,  and  caused  to   be  in- 
-structed  in  all  the  sciences  of  Persia.     This 
man,  after  the  woman's  death,  changed  his 
name,  to  obliterate  the  memory  of  his  first 
condition,  and  assumed  that  of  Manes.     He 
pretended  to  he  the  apostle  of  Christ,  and 
ithat  he   was   the   Comforter  our    Saviour 
promised  to  send.     He  promised  Sapor,  the 
Iving  of  Persia,  that  he  would  cure  his  son ; 
whereupon  the   father   sent  away  all  the 
physicians,  and  the  patient  died  soon  after : 
whereupon    Manes    was    imprisoned.     He 
made  his  escape,  and  in  exile  surrounded 
himself    with     devoted     followers.       His 
preaching  penetrated  the  Roman  empire  of 
Valerian  and  Gallienus.     Sapor's  son  Hor- 
misdas  recalled  him,  but  Magian  jealousy 
was  against  him.     In  the  reign  of  Vasanes, 
successor  of  Hormisdas,  he  was  induced  to 
•dispute  with  the  Magi,  and  being  adjudged 
the  loser,  was  flayed  alive." — Acta  Arclielai 
cum  Manete,  m.  53,  p.  97;  Epiphan.  adv. 
Hxr.  46  (See  Diet.  Christ.  Biog.  v.  3). 

Manes  held  that  there  were  two  principles, 
the  one  good — Oimuzd — from  whence  pro- 


MANICHiEANS 


4G9 


ceeded  the  good  soul  of  man,  and  the  other 
bad — Ahriman— from  whence  proceeded  the 
evil  soul,  and  likewise  the  body  with  all 
corporeal  creatures.  He  taught  his  disciples 
to  profess  a  great  severity  of  life,  notwith- 
standing which  they  were  able  to  wallow 
in  all  impurity,  and  he  forbade  to  give  alms 
to  any  that  were  not  of  his  own  sect.  He 
attributed  the  motions  of  concupiscence  to 
the  evil  soul ;  he  gave  out  that  the  souls  of 
his  followers  went  through  the  elements  to 
the  moon,  and  afterwards  to  the  sun,  to  be 
purified,  and  then  to  -God,  in  whom  they 
did  rejoin;  and  those  of  other  men,  he 
alleged,  went  to  hell,  to  be  sent  into  other 
bodies.  He  alleged,  that  Christ  had  His 
residence  in  the  sun ;  the  Holy  Ghost  in  the 
air ;  wisdom  in  the  moon ;  and  the  Father 
in  the  abyss  of  light :  he  denied  the  resur- 
rection, and  condemned  marriage ;  he  held 
Pythagoras's  transmigration  of  souls ;  that 
Christ  had  no  real  body ;  that  He  was  neither 
dead  nor  risen,  and  that  He  was  the  Serpent 
that  tempted  Eve.  He  forbade  the  use  of 
eggs,  cheese,  milk,  and  wine,  as  creatures 
proceeding  from  a  bad  principle  ;  he  used  a 
form  of  baptism  different  from  that  of  the 
Church  (Aug.  de  Hmr.  46).  He  taught  that 
magistrates  were  not  to  be  obeyed,  and  con- 
demned the  most  lawful  wars.  It  is  next  to 
impossible  to  recount  all  the  impious  and 
fantastic  tenets  of  this  heresiarch,  which 
caused  Leo  the  Great  to  say  of  him,  that  "the 
devil  reigned  in  all  other  heresies,  but  he  had 
built  a  fortress  and  raised  his  throne  in  that 
of  the  Manichajans,  who  embraced  all  the 
errors  and  impieties  that  the  spirit  of  man 
was  capable  of;  for  whatever  profanation  was 
in  Paganism,  carnal  blindness  in  Judaism, 
unlawful  curiosity  in  magic,  or  sacrilegious 
in  other  heresies,  did  all  centre  in  that  of  the 
Manichajans." 

The  Manichajans  were  divided  into  two 
classes — the  elect,  and  the  hearers.  From 
the  former  were  selected  twelve  masters 
with  a  principal,  called  the  successor  of 
Manes.  Under  these  there  were  seventy- 
two  bishops,  with  presbyters  and  deacons, 
all  taken  from  the  elect,  though  the  elect, 
or  perfect,  included  many  of  the  laity.  It 
appears  that  no  distinction  of  sanctity 
existed  between  the  elect.  The  bishops  and 
priests  were  merely  ministerial,  and  the  lay 
members  were  on  a  perfect  equality  in  eccle- 
siastical matters.  It  was  perhaps  on  account 
of  this  tendency  to  a  democratical  form  of 
Church  government  that  so  many  embraced 
Manichasism,  and  when  in  after  ages  the 
heresy  was  revived,  it  was  not  so  much  on 
accovmt  of  the  absurd  doctrines  promulgated 
by  the  early  Manichajans,  as  from  the 
system  of  equality  which  they  held.  Valen- 
tinian  I.,  and  his  coadjutor  Gratian,  tolerant 
as  he  was,  excepted  these  heretics  from  an 


470 


JIANIPLE 


amnesty  given  to  all  others.  The  edicts  of 
Theodosius  decreed  death  to  the  elect,  out- 
lawry to  the  hearers ;  and  the  second 
Valentinian  and  Honorius  confirmed  the 
severe  enactments.  Yet  they  renewed  their 
opinions  in  Africa,  Gaul,  and  Rome,  where  a 
council  was  held  against  them.  Manicliajism 
continued  to  exist  in  the  middle  ages,  among 
the  sects  called  Cathari,  Paterini,  or  Alhi- 
genses. — Walch,  Hist,  der  Ketzereien,  i.  724  ; 
Eose's  Neander,  ii.  140 ;  Lardner's  Cred. 
Gos.  Hist.  pt.  ii.  vol.  iii. ;  Stubhs'  Soames' 
Moslieim,  vol.  i.  198-203. 

MANIPLE,  or  MANUPLE  {Manipulus, 
sometimes  called  Fanon,  or  Plianon,  and 
Sudarium).  Originally  a  narrow  stri^j  of 
linen  as  wide  as  a  stole,  and  about  two  and 
a  half  feet  long,  suspended  from  the  lelt 
arm  of  the  priest,  and  used  as  a  kind  of 
sudarium  for  wiping  the  hands  (manus),  and 
for  other  cleanly  purposes.  Gradually  it 
received  embellishments ;  it  was  bordered  by 
a  fringe,  and  decorated  with  needlework.  In 
the  eleventh  century  it  was  given  to  the 
sub-deacons  as  the  badge  of  their  order.  It 
is  distinguished  from  the  epigonaton  by 
being  worn  on  the  left  side.  The  maniple 
is  not  retained  among  the  ecclesiastical 
vestments  of  the  Church  of  England. 

MANSE  (Mansus,  Mansio).  The  man- 
sus  was  originally  a  piece  of  land  of  twelve 
acres  (Ducange),  and  the  mansus  ecclesize 
came  to  mean  the  land  with  which  the 
Church  was  endowed,  or  the  glebe.  Then 
the  house  upon  it  had  the  title,  and  in 
England  the  manse  was  the  ancient  name 
(as  appears  from  old  records)  for  an  eccle- 
siastical residence,  whether  parochial  or  col- 
legiate. A  Prankish  mansus  was  the  al- 
lotment sufficient  to  maintain  a  family 
(Palgrave,  Ang.  Can.  Com.  ii.  448).  In 
Scotland  it  was  peculiarly  appropriated  to 
parsonage  houses;  and  now  designates  the 
residences  of  the  ministers  of  the  Pres- 
byterian estabhshment.  It  was  anciently 
applied  also  to  the  prebendal  houses  there 
(See  M'Ure's  History  of  Glasgoiv). 

MANSIONAMES.  Officers  who  had  a 
certain  charge  in  the  Church,  either  with 
regard  to  the  fabric  or  the  service.  Ma- 
biUon  calls  them  "  mansionarii  seu  custodes 
ecclesiarum." — Comm.  Frxv.  p.  xxvii. ;  Diet. 
Christ.  Ant. 

MANUDUCTOR  (Lat),  in  the  ancient 
Christian  Church,  was  an  officer,  who,  from 
the  middle  of  the  choir,  where  he  was 
placed,  gave  the  signal  to  the  choristers  to 
sing,  marked  the  measm'e,  beat  the  time, 
and  regulated  the  music.  He  was  so  called 
because  he  led  or  guided  the  choir  by  the 
motions  and  gesture  of  the  hand. 

The  Greeks  called  the  same  kind  of 
officer  Mesochoros,  because  he  was  seated 
in  the  middle  of  the  choir. 


MARCIONITES 

MARANATHA  :  a  Greek  equivalent  for 
the  Aramaic  words  Sns  pD,  "our  Lord 
Cometh,"  a  word  added 'to  Anathema  by  St. 
Paul  to  strengthen  the  preceding  excom- 
munication (See  Anatliema).  It  is  referred 
to  by  St.  Chiysostom,  St.  Jerome,  and 
others  ;  but  does  not  seem  to  have  been  part 
of  the  usual  form  of  excommunication. — 
Diet,  of  Bible,  s.  v. ;  Bingham,  xvi.,  ii.  [H.], 

MAECELLIANS.  Followers  of  Mar- 
cellus,  bishop  of  Ancyra,  in  Galatia,  against 
whom  the  charge,  according  to  Sozomen, 
was,  that  he  held  the  Son  of  God  to  have 
His  beginning  from  His  birth  of  the  Virgin 
(H.  E.  ii.  33).  This  idea  apparently  first 
came  out  in  a  book  by  Marcellus  against 
the  Arians  (Hilary,  Frag.  Hist.  ii.  22,  col. 
1300,  Ed.  Bened.),  and  indeed  Athanasius 
for  some  time  upheld  the  orthodoxy  of  the 
bishop  of  Ancyra ;  but  at  length  he  had  to 
suspend  him  from  communion,  and  he  was 
condemned  at  Constantinople.  He  taught 
that  the  Son  had  no  real  personality,  but 
was  merely  the  external  manifestation  of 
the  Father  (TrpofftopiKoc  Xdyoj) ;  and  that 
it  was  only  as  man  that  He  was  called  the 
Son  of  God.  His  peculiar  opinions  are- 
dra\vn  out  by  Cardinal  Ne^vman  from  Eu- 
sebius  (Select  Treat,  of  St.  Athan.  p.  503),. 
and  seem  to  be  a  sort  of  mixture  of  th& 
errors  of  Sabellius  and  Paul  of  Samosata 
(See  Sdbellians). 

MARCIONITES.  Heretics  of  the  se- 
cond century ;  so  called  from  Marcion.  Ho 
was  bom  at  Sinope,  in  Paplilagonia  or 
Helenopontus,  on  the  coast  of  the  Pontus 
Euxinus,  or  Black  Sea,  and  for  that  reason 
is  sometimes  called  Ponticus.  He  studied 
the  Stoic  philosophy  in  his  younger  years,, 
and  was  a  lover  of  solitude  and  poverty.  He 
was  said  to  have  been  guilty  of  uncleanness- 
with  a  virgin,  and  was,  by  his  father,  who 
was  a  bishop,  expelled  the  Church.  This- 
however  only  rests  upon  the  authority  of  Epi- 
phanius ;  and  Tertullian  speaks  of  Marcior^ 
as  pure  and  continent  (De  Prmscript. 
Hxr.  30).  Probably  by  the  "  Virgin  "  off 
Epiphanius  is  figured  the  virgin  Church, 
which  was  corrupted  by  his  errors.  After 
this  he  went  to  Rome,  where,  being  not  adj- 
mitted  into  Church  communion,  he  in. 
spite  embraced  Cerdon's  heresy,  and  be- 
came the  author  of  new  heresies,  about  a.d. 
134.  He  held  with  Cerdon  the  doctrine  of" 
two  gods,  the  one  good,  the  other  bad ;  the 
latter,  he  said,  was  the  author  of  the  world, 
and  of  the  law;  but  "the  good,  was  the 
author  of  the  gospel,  and  redeemer  of  the- 
world.  He  said  that  Christ  was  sent  on 
purpose  to  abolish  the  law,  as  being  bad. 
Origen  affirms,  that  he  supposed  there  was- 
a  G-od  of  the  Jews,  a  God  of  the  Chris- 
tians, and  a  God  of  the  Gentiles.  Tertul- 
lian wrote  against  him,  and  brought  forward 


MAEGAEET,  ST. 

the  rest  of  his  opinions,  as  that  he  denied 
the  resurreotipn  of  the  body,  condemned 
marriage ;  a  married  man  who  offered  him- 
self as  a  disciple  being  received  as  a  cate- 
chumen, but  not  admitted  to  baptism  till 
he  had  separated  from  his  wife  ('I'ert.  adv. 
Marc.  i.  29:  iv.  10).  The  baptism  of 
married  persons  was  only  allowed  in 
articuZo  mortis.  The  womeu  commonly 
administered  the  sacraments.  Ehodon,  a 
Greek  author,  quoted  by  Busebius,  says, 
the  disciples  of  this  heresiarch  added  many 
other  errors  to  his  tenets.  Constantine  the 
Great  pubhshed  an  edict  against  the 
Marcionites  and  the  other  heretics  in  366 ; 
and  Theodoret,  bishop  of  Cyrus,  converted 
10,000  of  them  in  420  (For  full  account 
see  Diet.  CJirist.  Biog.  iii.  816). 

MAEGABET,  ST.,  V.  and  M.,  of  An- 
tioch;  commemorated  in  our  Calendar  on 
July  20.  Nothing  is  kno\vn  of  this  saint, 
but  there  is  a  tradition  that  she  suffered 
martyrdom  at  Antioch  in  Pisidia  about  a.d. 
278.  In  the  Greek  Church  she  is  called  St. 
Marina,  and  commemorated  on  the  17th  of 
July.  Her  legend  is  one  of  those  pronounced 
by  Pope  Gelasius  in  494  as  apocryphal.  [H.] 
MAtilOLATRY.  The  worship  of  the 
Virgin  Mary,  or  rendering  to  the  Blessed 
Virgin  that  service  (_Latreia,  which  see) 
which  belongs  only  to  God.  This  did  not 
take  place  in  the  early  ages  of  the  Church. 
"  God  alone,"  wrote  Justin  Martyr,  "  ought 
Christians  to  worship"  (roc  Gfoi/  iiomv  Sel 
TTpoa-Kvveiv.  Apol.  ii.) ;  and  similar  expres- 
sions are  used  frequently  by  the  Fathers. 

Praying  to  the  Virgin  was  first  in- 
troduced in  the  fourth  century,  and  was 
regarded  as  a  heresy  by  the  Catholic 
Church.  It  commenced  in  Arabia,  about 
the  year  373,  and  seems  to  have  given 
rise  to  the  opposite  heresy,  that  of  the 
Antidicomariaiis,  who  spoke  irreverently 
of  the  Blessed  Virgin.  We  learn  that  the 
simple  and  misguided  persons,  who  adopted 
this  new  worship,  made  offerings  of  cakes 
to  the  Virgin,  from  which  they  were  called 
Collyridians  (a  word  which  signified  the 
nature  of  the  offering).  There  is  no  evi- 
dence that  they  separated  from  the  Church 
or  its  worship,  or  refused  to  worship  God, 
or  regarded  the  Virgin  as  equal  with  God. 
They,  however,  offered  external  worship  to 
the  Virgin,  and  were,  therefore,  regarded 
as  heretics.  In  the  following  century,  a 
reaction  against  the  Nestorian  refusal  of 
the  title  Theotolcos  (Mother  of  God)  to  the 
Blessed  Virgin,  tended  greatly  to  pave  the 
way  for  the  Mariolatry  of  later  times  (See 
Nestorians ;  Motlier  of  God).  It  is  not 
denied  that  both  in  the  Greek  and  Eoman 
Church  the  Virgin  is  directly  addressed  in 
prayer.  She  seems  to  be  more  regarded 
than  God ;  or,  at  all  events,  to  be  considered 


MARK,  ST. 


471 


as  the  complement  of  the  Trinity. — Pusey's 
Eirenicon,  ii.  167  (See  Hook's  Church  and 
her  Ordinances,  vol.  ii.  p.  189). 

MAEK,  ST.,  THE  EVANGELIST'S 
DAY.  A  festival  of  the  Christian  Church, 
observed  on  the  25th  of  April. 

St.  Mark  is  generally  identified  with  the 
John  surnamed  Mark,  to  the  house  of  whose 
mother  Mary.  St.  Peter  repaired  after  his 
deliverance  from  prison  (Acts  xii.  12).  He 
was  nephew  to  St.  Barnabas,  and  started 
with  him  and  St.  Paul  on  their  first  mission- 
ary journey,  but  left  them  at  Perga,  and  was 
therefore  rejected  by  St.  Paul  on  the  second 
journey.  But  it  is  clear  from  Col.  iv.  10, 
Philem.  24,  and  2  Tim.  iv.  11,  that  he 
regained  St.  Paul's  confidence,  and  was  sent 
for  to  minister  to  him  in  his  last  imprison- 
ment. He  is  called  by  St.  Peter  (1  St.  Pet. 
V.  13),"  my  son,"  and  early  tradition  makes 
him  the  constant  companion  of  St.  Peter,  and 
describes  him  as  having  written  his  gospel 
under  the  guidance,  if  not  at  the  dictation, 
of  that  apostle.  He  is  said  to  have  been 
sent  by  St.  Peter  into  Egypt,  fixing  his 
chief  residence  at  Alexandria,  but  carrying 
also  the  gospel  into  the  less  civilized  parts 
of  Africa.  According  to  tradition  not  very 
trustworthy,  he  suffered  martyrdom  one 
Easter  late  in  the  first  century,  at  the 
time  the  solemnities  of  Serapis  were  cele- 
brated, when  the  idolatrous  people,  being 
excited  to  vindicate  the  honour  of  their 
deity,  broke  in  upon  St.  Mark,  while  he 
was  ijerforming  Divine  service,  and,  binding 
him  with  cords,  dragged  him  through  the 
streets,  and  thrust  him  into  prison,  where 
in  the  night  he  had  the  comfort  of  a 
Divine  vision.  Next  day,  the  enraged  mul- 
titude used  him  in  the  same  manner,  till, 
his  spirits  failing,  he  expired  under  their 
hands.  Some  add,  that  they  burnt  his  body, 
and  that  the  Christians  decently  interred 
his  bones  and  ashes  near  the  place  where  he 
used  to  preach. 

MAEK'S,  ST.,  GOSPEL.  A  canonical 
book  of  the  New  Testament  (See  the  pre- 
ceding article). 

This  evangelist  wrote  his  gospel  at  Eome, 
whither  he  accompanied  St.  Peter  in  the 
year  of  Christ  44.  Tertullian,  and  others, 
pretend  that  St.  Mark  was  no  more  than 
an  amanuensis  to  St.  Peter,  who  dictated 
this  Gospel  to  him.  Others  affirm  that  he 
wrote  it  after  St.  Peter's  death.  On  the 
authenticity  of  the  last  twelve  verses  in  this 
gospel,  see  Appendix. 

MAEK,  ST.,  LITUEGY  OF  ;  called  also 
the  Liturgy  of  Alexandria.  This  was 
anciently  used  in  Greek,  but  is  also  extant 
in  Coptic,  in  modified  forms  which  go  by 
the  names  of  St.  Cyril,  St.  Basil,  and  St. 
Gregory  "  the  Theologian"  (Nazianzen),  and 
which  are  used  to  the  present  day  by  the 


472 


MAEONITES 


Christians  of  Egypt.  The  Greek  hturgy  of 
St.  Mark  in  full  exists  only  in  one  MS.  of 
about  the  tenth  century  (Eenaudot,  i.  45. 
Asseman,  Lod.  Liturg.  vii.),  but  by  a  chain 
of  evidence,  and  by  comparison  with  the 
other  forms,  it  can  be  traced  back  to  the 
earliest  ages.  We  can  ascertain  with  con- 
siderable certainty  the  words  and  expressions 
of  the  Alexandrian  liturgy  before  the  Council 
of  Chalcedon,  a.d.  451 :  and  its  substance 
and  order  to  a  far  more  remote  period.  In 
fact  there  is  nothing  unreasonable  in  sup- 
posing that,  in  its  main  substance,  it  was  as 
old  as  the  apostolic  age ;  and  derived  from 
the  instruction  of  St.  Mark  (Palmer,  Orig. 
Liturg.  i.  105).  The  "Anaphora"  of  the 
Liturgy  of  St.  Mark  is  almost  identical  with 
that  of  the  English  office,  "  Lift  we  up  our 
hearts,"  "  We  lift  them  up  imto  the  Lord," 
&c.  "  Let  us  give  thanks  unto  the  Lord." 
"  It  is  meet  and  right."  "  It  is  verily  meet 
and  right,"  &c.     [TBL] 

MARONITES.  Certain  Eastern  Chris- 
tians, so  called,  who  inhabit  the  slopes  of 
Lebanon  and  A  nti-Lebanon,  in  Syria.  The 
name  is  derived  probably  from  the  Monastery 
of  St.  Maro,  where  they  at  first  assembled, 
under  a  leader  who  took  the  name  Maro  or 
Marum,  and  assumed  the  title  of  Patriarch 
of  Antioch.  The  monastery  had  been 
founded  in  the  fifth  century  by  Maro  the 
Anchorite,  but  the  sect  which  assumed  the 
name  did  not  arise  till  the  beginning  of  the 
eighth  century,  when  a  certain  number  of 
persons  separated  themselves  from  the  or- 
thodox church,  and  adopted  Monothehte 
teaching  (See  Monothelites).  Though  there 
were  other  Monothelite  bishops,  this  was 
the  only  distinct  sect  which  arose  from  that 
heresy.  In  a.d.  1182  they  entered  into  the 
Roman  communion  40,000  in  number ;  but 
when  the  Latin  kingdom  of  Jerusalem  was 
destroyed  they  ceased  for  two  centuries  to 
have  any  intercourse  with  Western  Christen- 
dom. They  were  re-united  at  the  Council 
of  Florence,  a.d.  1445.  The  Maronites  have 
their  patriarch,  archbishops,  bishops,  and 
about  150  inferior  clergy.  They  keep  Lent 
according  to  the  ancient  rigour,  eating  but 
one  meal  a  day,  and  that  after  mass,  which 
is  said  at  four  o'clock  in  the  afternoon. 
Their  priests  are  distinguished  by  a  blue 
scarf,  which  they  wear  about  their  caps. 
Married  men  may  become  priests,  but  none 
may  marry  after  they  are  in  orders.  They 
wear  no  surplices,  observe  particular  fasts 
and  feasts,  and  differ  in  many  other  things 
from  the  Church  of  Rome. 

The  patriarch  of  the  Maronites  is  a  monk 
of  St.  Anthony,  claims  the  title  of  Patriarch 
of  Antioch,  and  is  always  called  Peter.  He 
has  about  nine  bishops  under  him,  and 
resides  at  Edem  Canobin,  a  monastery  built 
on  a  rock.     They  read  their  service  both  in 


MAEKIAGE 

the  vulgar  language  and  in  Latin,  and, 
while  they  perform  it,  turn,  their  heads 
sometimes  on  one  side,  and  sometimes  on 
the  other,  pronouncing  the  word  Num  or 
Kynam  softly,  which  signifies  yes  or  yes 
verily,  by  which  they  express  their  assent 
to  what  they  read.  They  have  so  great  a 
veneration  for  their  bishops,  that  they  often 
prostrate  themselves  before  them. — LeQuien, 
Oriens.  Clirist.  iii.  10;  Neale's  Eastern 
Church,  Introd.  i.  153. 

MARRIAGE  (See  also  Divorce).  (Fr. 
mariage:  from  Low  Latin  maritagium, 
maritus).  The  union  between  man  and 
woman  for  life.  It  was  instituted  by 
God  (Gen.  i.  28,  ii.  18,  24),  and  amongst 
the  different  nations  of  the  world  there  has 
almost  universally  been  some  rehgious  way 
of  entering  into  it,  as  a  testimony  of  its 
divine  institution  (Wheatly,  p.  402).  It 
was  so  in  the  early  Christian  Church. 
Marriage  being  spoken  of  as  typical  of  the 
union  between  Christ  and  His  Church 
(Eph.  V.  31),  shows  vAth.  what  regard  it 
was  observed,  and  the  early  Fathers  were 
very  earnest  in  bringing  it  before  the 
people  as  a  religious  and  not  a  mere  natural 
contract.  Ignatius,  early  in  the  second 
century,  says :  "  It  becomes  those  that 
marry  and  are  given  in  marriage  to  take 
upon  them  this  yoke  with  the  consent  or 
direction  of  the  bishop,  that  their  marriage 
may  be  according  to  the  will  of  God,  and 
not  their  own  lusts "  (^Ep.  ad  Polycarp.). 
TertulHan,  a  little  later,  says :  "  How  can 
we  find  words  to  describe  the  happiness  of 
that  marriage  which  the  Church  brings 
about,  and,  the  oblation  confirms,  and  the 
benediction  seals,  and  the  angels  announce, 
and  the  Father  ratifies"  (Ad  Ux.  ii.  8). 
St.  Ambrose,  also,  speaks  of  the  benediction 
iEp.  70),  and  St.  Augustine  says  that  the 
bishops  used  to  give  women  in  marriage, 
thereby  implying  the  blessing,  but  they 
could  not  give  them  to  heathens  {Ep.  234 ; 
see  also  Possid.  Vit.  Aug.  c.  27).  A  good 
deal  of  laxity  took  place  on  account  of  the 
marriages  between  Christians  and  heathens, 
the  questions  with  regard  to  afSnity,  and 
second  marriages.  But  about  a'.d.  780  Charles 
the  Great  enacted  a  law  that  no  marriage 
should  be  celebrated  but  by  blessing  with 
sacerdotal  prayers  and  oblations — so  that 
the  necessity  of  sacerdotal  benediction  was 
established  by  law.  In  our  country  similar 
enactments  were  made.  A  law  of  King 
Edward  (a.d.  946)  orders  that  "  the  priest 
shall  be  at  the  marriage,  and  shall  celebrate 
the  union  according  to  custom,  with  God's 
blessing,  and  with  solemnity "  (For  Mar- 
riage service  see  Matrimony).    [H.] 

MARRIAGE,  LAW  OF.  The  only 
definition  of  marriage  that  can  be  main- 
tained in  this  country  is  "  The  legal  union 


MAREIAOE 

of  one  man  and  one  woman,  professedly 
for  life,  and  with  no  power  for  either  or 
both  of  them  to  dissolve  it."  The  Judge  of 
the  Divorce  Court  has  held  that  a  professedly 
polygamous  union  in  a  country  which 
allows  it  is  not  a  marriage  in  English  law. 
How  it  is  to  be  made  is  a  subordinate 
question,  and  the  law  thereon  has  varied 
from  time  to  time,  and  has  often  had 
to  be  settled  by  judicial  decisions  as  well 
as  altered  by  legislation.  The  last  great 
case  upon  it  was  Reg.  v.  MUlis,  in  1843-4, 
when  a  majority  of  the  Irish  Judges,  and 
the  English  ones  unanimously,  came  to 
an  important  conclusion,  which  neverthe- 
less only  stood  by  an  equal  division  in 
the  House  of  Lords.  The  decision  itself 
has  ceased  to  be  of  so  much  consequence 
by  reason  of  later  legislation,  but  the 
judgments  of  Tindal,  L.C.J.,  for  all  the 
judges  who  were  not  peers,  and  of  Lord 
Cottenham,  and  above  all,  the  luminous 
exposition  of  Lord  Lyndhurst,  contain  such 
a  history  of  the  English  law  of  marriage 
as  never  had  been  or  will  be  written 
again.  Lord  Abinger's,  who  concurred, 
was  only  short.  Backed  by  such  a 
vast  preponderance  of  authority  we  may 
venture  to  add  that  the  reasoning  of  the 
three  dissentients,  Lords  Brougham,  Camp- 
bell and  Denman,  is  plainly  wrong  on  some 
points  and  was  avowedly  hasty.  Lynd- 
hurst and  Cottenham's  judgments  were 
postponed  tiU  the  following  session.  Camp- 
bell's Scotch  prepossessions  made  him  sin- 
gularly inaccurate  sometimes  in  speaking 
and  writing  about  English  marriage  law. 
All  these  judgments  were  printed  as  Par- 
liamentary papers,  and  the  case  is  reported 
in  10  Clark  and  Finnelly,  and  is  well  worth 
reading  still. 

The  main  decision  of  all  the  Courts,  to 
which  all  the  rest  of  their  investigation  led 
up,  was  that  the  performance  of  some 
recognised  marriage  ceremony  by  a  priest 
(which  word  was  said  to  include  a  deacon 
since  the  Reformation  Statutes,  and  even  a 
Roman  priest)  had  always  been  essential  in 
England  to  the  making  of  a  complete  mar- 
riage, carrying  all  the  civil  rights  of  dower 
to  the  wife  and  the  husband's  power  over 
her  personalty  and  the  legitimacy  of  children, 
until  the  Act  of  1836,  authorising  civil 
marriages  before  Registrars.  For  some  un- 
certain period  long  before  the  great  Marriage 
Act  of  1753  it  seemed  to  be  held  that  the 
marriage  by  a  priest  must  also  be  in  church ; 
but  that  (if  it  ever  really  was  law)  had  long 
ceased  to  be  so.  The  exceptions  which  had 
been  assumed  to  exist  for  Jews  and  Quakers 
need  not  be  now  considered,  and  the  legality 
of  that  for  Quakers  seemed  doubtful  until 
later  Acts,  and  was  once  decided  against. 
The  aforesaid  Marriage  Act,  26  Geo.  IL  c.  33, 


MARRIAGE 


473 


was  aimed  at  clandestine  marriages  (which 
some  writers  wrongly  confounded  with 
marriages  without  a  priest),  and  absolutely 
required  performance  in  a  church  after 
banns  or  licence,  and  between  8  and  12  a.m., 
and  made  all  others  null  and  void,  and  the 
clergyman  who  knowingly  celebrated  them, 
liable  to  fourteen  years'  transportation,  and 
no  less ;  all  which  is  followed  by  4  Geo.  I  \'. 
c.  76.  By  an  Act  of  1886  the  time  is 
extended  to  3  p.m.  and  the  clergy  are 
exempted  from  the  penalties  of  the  62Qd 
Canon  in  respect  thereof  which  had  been 
overridden  by  several  other  Acts  of  Parlia- 
ment before.  But  it  rather  strangely  did 
not  expressly  require  a  priest;  and  Lord 
Stowell  thought,  and  some  of  the  Lords 
in  the  above  case  followed  him,  that  a  false 
priest  would  not  vitiate  a  marriage  if  the 
parties  married  were  innocent;  but  that 
has  never  yet  been  actually  decided.  The 
false  priest  himself  is  certainly  liable  to  that 
penalty,  and  one  was  convicted  and  sentenced 
not  long  ago. 

In  order  to  arrive  at  the  main  conclusion 
in  that  case  of  Seg.  v.  Millis,  the  judges  and 
the  Lords  had  to  wade  through  and  classify 
as  far  as  possible  a  quagmire  of  complica- 
tions and  contradictions  that  had  accu- 
mulated under  encroachments  of  the  Canon 
Law  from  Rome,  which  had  naturally  in- 
vaded the  ecclesiastical  Courts  in  matters 
within  their  exclusive  jurisdiction  and  in- 
volving no  conflict  with  the  common  law 
Courts ;  which  would  never  have  allowed 
one  wife  and  one  set  of  children  to  bo 
lawful  for  some  purposes,  and  another  set 
for  others  in  this  country,  though  the  eccle- 
siastical Courts  administered  the  personal 
estate  of  dead  people,  but  not  the  real,  until 
ttie  transfer  of  all  that  jurisdiction  to  the  new 
Probate  Court  in  1857,  which  became  the 
Divorce  Court  at  the  same  time  by  another 
Act.  The  advocates  of  reviving  Canon  law 
and  lawyers  (who  can  never  define  what 
they  mean)  will  probably  be  surprised  to 
leam  that  it  was  that,  and  not  the  common 
law  of  England,  which  ordained  that  a  priest 
was  7wt  necessary  to  make  a  valid  marriage, 
which  could  not  be  dissolved ;  and  so  it 
remained  in  the  Roman  Church  imtil  the 
Council  of  I'rent. 

Solemnization  of  the  marriage  by  a  priest 
in  church  would  however  be  ordered  by 
the  ecclesiastical  Court  upon  a  proved  mar- 
riage contract  per  verba  de  prsesenti,  such  as 
"  I  take  thee  for  my  wife,"  though  not  de 
futuro,  such  as,  "  I  promise  to  marry  you," 
rmless  it  was  followed  by  consummation. 
But  that  was  far  from  being  the  only  com- 
plication. Dropping  then  mere  promises 
inoonsummated,  if  A  and  B  contracted  to 
marry,  and  if  before  solemnization  in  church, 
A  went   and  married   C  in  facie  ecdesise. 


474 


MARRIAGE 


■which  were  his  la wf ul  wife  and  children  ?  That 
question  nobody  could  answer  until  another 
suit  had  been  instituted;  and  again  that 
would  depend  on  whether  A  and  C  were 
both  alive  still.  If  they  were  not,  the  C 
marriage  stood  irrevocable:  if  they  were, 
the  Court  would  dissolve  the  C  marriage, 
and  pronounce  it  null  and  void  ah  initio, 
though  it  had  been  only  voidable ;  and  that, 
whether  any  order  had  been  previously 
made  to  celebrate  the  B  marriage  or  not. 
If  B  was  meanwhile  dead,  it  was  no  use 
ordering  her  to  be  married  in  church,  and 
therefore  probably  C  remained  A's  wife. 
But  whether  she  did  or  not,  and  whatever 
else  happened,  the  children  of  B  born 
before  she  had  been  married  by  a  priest 
were  illegitimate  by  the  law  of  England; 
and  if  B  outlived  A,  but  had  not  been  so 
married,  she  could  not  recover  dower.  An 
attempt  was  made  by  the  bishops  in  1235 
to  introduce  another  piece  of  Canon  law: 
and  the  Statute  of  Merton,  20  Hen.  III., 
c.  9,  is,  "  And  all  the  bishops  instanted  the 
lords  that  they  would  consent  that  such 
as  were  born  before  matrimony  should  be 
legitimate  .  .  .  forasmuch  as  the  Church 
accepteth  such  for  legitimate;  and  all  the 
barons  answered  with  one  voice  that  they 
would  not  change  the  laws  of  the  realm." 
It  is  curious  that  that  law  of  the  Roman 
Church  still  prevails  in  Presbyterian  Scot- 
land, and  that  is  why  no  minister  need 
be  present  to  make  a  valid  marriage  there. 
Lord  Campbell,  in  J?,  v.  Millis,  referred  to 
another  famous  decision  (unnamed)  in  the 
House  of  Lords,  that  a  family  of  illegitmate 
children  was  once  made  legitimate  by  a 
mun  declaring  their  mother  to  be  his 
wife  before  his  servants,  and  then  going 
into  the  next  room  and  shooting  himself 
As  some  persons  desire  to  see  that  premium 
impudicitix  of  the  Canon  law  introduced 
here,  we  may  give  this  purely  civil  reason 
against  it,  that  it  would  enable  an  unmarried 
man  to  spite  his  real  heir  by  adopting  any 
boy  with  a  living  mother  just  before  his 
death,  when  men  sometimes  do  very  queer 
things  as  it  is.  It  is  also  a  manifest  tempta- 
tion to  postpone  marriage  and  live  in  con- 
cubinage. 

This  monstrous  state  of  things  continued 
Tmtil  1753,  except  that  it  was  stopped  for  a 
few  years  by  32  Hen.  VIII.  c.  38,  which 
was  itself  afterwards  repealed  as  to  its  re- 
peal of  those  "  precontracts,"  as  they  were 
called.  It  is  not  necessary  to  follow  up  all 
the  consequences  of  that  contradiction  of 
the  common  and  the  ecclesiastical  law,  under 
which  nobody  could  be  sure  which  of  two 
wives  a  man  might  finally  discover  to  be  his 
real  one,  until  cither  he  or  one  of  them  was 
dead,  or  whether  his  children  by  the  second 
marriage,   if  duly   performed,  were   to  be 


MARRIAGE 

legitimate  or  not.  Nor  is  it  necessary  to- 
explain  here  how  far  the  Irish  law  was 
aftected  by  the  Marriage  Act  of  1753  and 
others,  so  as  to  cause  the  difficulty  in  Reg. 
V.  Millis,  as  all  such  law  is  obsolete  now. 

That  Act  against  clandestine  marriages, 
and  especially  such  as  used  to  be  performed 
by  clergymen  in  the  Fleet  piison  and  other 
such  places,  and  that  one  of  4  Geo.  IV.  c. 
76,  which  was  substituted  for  it,  have  been 
already  noticed  under  Banns ;  for  which 
licences,  either  ordinary  from  the  bishops  or 
their  chancellors,  or  special  from  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury  only  under  25  Hen. 
VIII.  c.  21,  "as  the  Pope  had  done  before," 
were  an  authorised  substitute.  And  as 
licences  by  their  very  nature  are  not 
intended  to  give  public  notice  of  a  mar- 
riage, mistakes  in  them  are  not  regarded 
so  strictly  as  in  banns,  where  a  materially 
wrong  name  (but  not  residence)  is  fatal, 
notwithstanding  the  strong  desire  of  the 
Courts  to  uphold  marriages,  even  where  the 
parties,  or  one  of  them,  are  punishable  for 
making  them.  It  is  impossible  to  give  here- 
a  complete  account  of  all  the  legal  distiuc- 
tions  that  have  been  made. 

A  licence  cannot  be  granted  for  the 
marriage  of  a  minor  without  the  consent  of 
a  parent  or  legal  guardian  or  the  Com't  of 
Chancery,  and  when  that  cannot  con- 
veniently be  got,  they  must  be  married  by 
banns,  and  often  are,  which  a  parent  may 
forbid  :  which  contravenes  the  62nd  Canon, 
rciquiring  the  parents'  express  consent.  Only 
a  special  licence  can  authorise  marriage  in 
a  house  or  outside  the  legal  hours,  and  they 
are  never  given  without  special  reasons 
being  at  least  alleged  for  inability  to  marry 
properly,  and  some  reference  to  known 
persons.  Of  late  too.  Archbishop  Tait 
wisely  refused  them  for  what  may  be 
called  evening  marriages,  which  were  apt 
to  degenerate  into  inappropriate  festivities. 
There  is  an  extra  stamp  duty  which  makes 
them  cost  about  £35.  An  ordinary  licence 
requires  the  residence  of  one  party  in  the 
parish  of  the  church  where  they  are  to  be 
married  for  at  least  fifteen  days,  and  one  of 
them  has  to  swear  before  the  surrogate  who 
grants  it  that  there  is  no  legal  impediment ; 
and  a  false  oath  therein  is  perjury,  but  does 
not  avoid  the  marriage,  unless  the  impedi- 
ment itself  does,  as  if  they  are  within  the 
prohibited  degrees  (See  Affinity).  The  same 
is  the  case  with  licences  from  a  Registrar. 
Also  the  party  making  a  false  declaration 
or  oath  is  liable  to  forfeit  all  interest  iu 
any  property  coming  through  the  marriage. 

Acts  have  still  to  be  passed  continually 
to  legalise  all  marriages  that  have  been 
performed  in  some  church  in  which  it  has 
been  found  or  thought  that  they  were  not 
lawful ;   and  if  not,  all  the  performers  of 


MAEKIAGE 

them  have  been  liable  to  transportation. 
Such  has  been  the  slovenly  way  of 
legislating  on  this  subject  at  every  period 
of  our  history  from  Henry  VIII.  down- 
wards. The  Act  called  Lord  Blandford's, 
19  &  20  Vict.  c.  104,  which  makes  all  places 
in  whose  churches  marriages  may  lawlully 
be  perforAed,  new  parishes  for  all  ecclesi- 
astical purposes  as  soon  as  the  vicars  are 
entitled  to  all  the  fees,  has  incidentally 
deprived  people  living  there  of  the  right  to  be 
still  married  in  the  old  parish  church,  as 
was  decided  in  Fuller  v.  Alford  in  1882, 
and  it  has  given  great  dissatisfaction — not 
much  compensated  by  the  decision  that 
they  retain  the  right  to  vote  for  church- 
wardens of  the  old  parish. 

The  Act  of  1880,  which  makes  Greenwich 
mean  time  the  only  lawful  time  in  Great 
Britain,  has  rendered  the  favourite  device  of 
putting  back  the  church  clocks  for  un- 
punctual  brides  fatal  to  their  marriage,  and 
the  clergyman  liable  to  transportation  if  he 
performs  it  late ;  but  the  service  need  only 
begin  before  the  prescribed  time,  now  3 
P.M.  It  is  singular  too  that  none  of 
these  Draconian  penalties  are  aimed  at  any 
irregularities  in  the  civil  marriages  before 
registrars  under  the  Marriage  Act  of  1836, 

6  &  7  W.  IV.  c.  85,  which  (as  usual)  has 
been  amended  by  sundry  others,  especially 

7  W.  IV.  c.  22,  and  3  &  4  Vict.  c.  72. 

It  was  doubtful  for  a  time  whether  a 
clergyman  could  lawfully  perform  the 
marriage  service  in  church  for  people  who 
desired  it  after  a  civil  marriage,  and  one 
was  actually  indicted  by  some  malicious 
person  for  so  doing.  But  a  strong  judge 
defeated  it  by  deciding  that  he  had  done 
simply  nothing,  except  read  the  church 
service  in  his  own  church,  and  had  not 
married  the  people  at  all,  as  they  were  married 
already.  Since  then  an  Act  was  passed 
expressly  allowing  it  in  1856  (19  &  20  Vict, 
c.  119,  s.  12),  on  production  of  the  registrar's 
certificate;  but  the  clergyman  is  not  to 
register  the  marriage,  as  it  is  registered 
already,  and  all  the  registers  now  go  to  the 
General  Itegistration  Office.  Clergymen 
who  are  asked  to  marry  persons  coming 
with  a  proper  licence,  or  whose  banns  have 
been  duly  published  in  that  church,  are 
not  bound  to  go  beyond  that  and  inqttire 
whether  they  have  been  married  in  a 
Impish  or  dissenting  chapel  or  a  registrar's 
office  beforehand.  By  the  first  section  of 
the  1836  Act  a  registrar  can  give  a  certificate 
of  notice  equivalent  to  banns  or  a  licence 
for  marriage  in  church,  though  that  was 
contrary  to  the  62nd  Canon.  It  was  agreed 
to  by  the  bishops  in  Parliament.  It  should  be 
remembered  that  licences  and  banns  only 
hold  good  for  three  months.  Clergymen  of 
experience   say  they  find  the  best  way  of 


MAKTYE 


475. 


receiving  the  fees  for  marriage  is  that 
directed  by  the  rubric.  They,  or  the  clerk,, 
tell  the  man  beforehand  that  ho  is  to  lay 
the  prescribed  fee  with  the  ring  on  the 
book  according  to  the  rubric,  or  if  more 
convenient,  on  a  plate  to  avoid  the  risk  of 
rolling  it  off.  There  are  many  complicated 
questions  about  the  effect  of  marriages- 
abroad,  which  cannot  be  discussed  here.  A 
man  may  easily  find  himself  to  have  one 
lawful  wife  abroad  and  another  here.     [G.] 

MARTIN,  ST. .  Bishop  and  Confessor  - 
commemorated  in  our  Calendar,  Nov.  11> 
He  was  bom  in  the  early  part  of  the  fourth, 
century  at  Sabaria,  a  town  of  Pannonia,. 
the  modem  Stain,  in  Hungary.  He  was- 
the  son  of  a  Soman  tribune,  and  himself  a. 
soldier,  though  from  all  accounts  from  a 
very  early  age  desirous  to  adopt  a  life  of" 
religion,  and  he  had  been  received  as  a. 
catechumen  at  the  age  of  fifteen.  Whea 
his  legion  was  quartered  at  Amiens  the 
well-known  incident  took  place  of  his 
cutting  his  cloak  in  two  portions  with  his- 
sword,  in  order  that  he  might  give  half  to  a 
naked  beggar,  covering  himself  as  best  he- 
might  with  the  other  half.  That  night  the- 
Blessed  Lord  appeared  to  him  in  a  vision,, 
clad  in  the  half  cloak,  and  seemed  to  say  to 
the  crowd  of  angels  around  Him,  "  Martin, 
still  a  catechumen,  has  clothed  me  with  this- 
cloak."  He  was  unmediately  baptized,  and 
shortly  afterwards  left  the  army.  Martin 
became  the  pupil  and  great  friend  of  Hilary 
of  Poic  tiers,  and  with  him  combated  the 
prevalent  errors  of  Arianism.  He  was- 
bishop  of  Tours  from  A.D.  371-397,  during; 
which  time  he  was  very  zealous,  destroying, 
the  heathen  temples,  throwing  down  their 
altars,  breaking  up  their  images,  &c.  In. 
397  he  died  at  Cande,  on  Nov.  11. — ^Robert- 
son's Ch.  Hist,  ii.,  v. ;  Diet.  Christ.  Biog.  iii. 
839.     [H.] 

MARTIN,  ST.,  TRANSLATION  OF. 
In  482,  Perpetuus,  bishop  of  Tours,  trans- 
lated the  remains  of  St.  Martin  to  a  splendid 
basilica  near  Tours.  This  event  is  celebrateA 
on  July  4.     [H.] 

MARTINMAS.  The  festival  of  St. 
Martin,  on  Nov.  11  (See  Martin,  St.). 

MARTYR  (jidprvp,  a  witness).  One- 
who  bears  testimony  to  Christ.  The  word 
was  sometimes  used  in  the  very  early^ 
Christian  authors  as  equivalent  to  teacher 
or  prophet  (Bus.  H.  E.  v.  xviii.  7),  but  it 
was  almost  universally  confined  to  those 
"  who  sealed  their  testimony  to  Jesus  and 
His  doctrine  with  their  blood"  (Rose's 
Pavkhurst,  s.  v.).  The  suffering  of  martyrs 
was  an  especial  cause  of  the  propagation 
of  the  Gospel,  and  so  it  became  a  saying, 
"  Semen  ecclesia^  est  sanguis  Christianorum  "' 
— "  the  blood  of  Christians  is  the  seed  of  the-- 
Church"  (Tertull.  Apol.  c.  49). 


476 


MARTYRDOM 


The  Christian  Cliurch,  fi-oni  the  time  of 
St.  Stephen,  the  first  martyr,  lias  abounded 
with  martyrs,  and  history  is  filled  with 
surprising  accounts  of  their  singular  con- 
stancy and  fortitude  under  the  most  cruel 
torments.  The  primitive  Christians  were 
falsely  accused  by  their  enemies  of  paying  a 
sort  of  Divine  worship  to  martrys.  Of  this 
we  have  an  instance  in  the  answer  of  the 
Church  of  Smyrna  to  the  suggestion  of  the 
Jews,  who,  at  the  martyrdom  of  Polycarp, 
•desired  the  heathen  judge  not  to  suffer  the 
Christians  to  carry  off  his  body,  lest  they 
should  leave  their  crucified  Master,  and 
worship  him  in  His  stead.  To  which  they 
answered,  "  We  can  neither  forsake  Christ, 
nor  worship  any  other  :  for  we  worship  Him 
ns  the  Son  of  God,  but  love  the  martyrs 
■as  the  disciples  and  followers  of  the  Lord, 
for  the  great  affection  they  have  shown  to 
■their  King  and  Master."  A  like  answer  was 
given  at  the  martyrdom  of  Pructuosus,  in 
Spain ;  for  when  the  judge  asked  Eulogius, 
Siis  deacon,  whether  he  would  not  worship 
Pructuosus,  as  thinking  that,  though  he 
refused  to  worship  heathen  idols,  he  might 
yet  be  inclined  to  worship  a  Christian 
martyr,  Eulogius  replied,  "  I  do  not  worship 
Fructuosus,  but  Him  whom  Fructuosus 
worships." 

In  answer  to  those  Manicha;ans  who 
accused  the  Church  of  worshipping  martyrs, 
St.  Augustine  denies  that  martyrs  were  ever 
Sionoured  with  worship  (XaTpela)  which  is 
•due  to  God  only :  they  were  honoured  as 
iioly  men  (Contra  Faust,  lib.  xx.  c.  21). 
And  St.  Jerome  answers  Vigilantius  in  the 
same  strain  (Contra.  Vigil.  7,  8).  The 
Church  loves  to  dwell  on  the  memory  of 
those  who  have  yielded  up  even  their  lives 
in  a  faithful  attachment  to  their  Redeemer, 
and  who,  from  the  midst  of  the  fires,  could 
rejoice  in  God,  and  trust  in  His  grace.  In 
that  beautiful  hjonn,  the  Te  Deum,  their 
memory  is  celebrated  in  the  words,  "The 
noble,"  or  (accordingio  the  original)  "white- 
robed  army  of  martyrs,  praise  thee."  And 
-well  may  they  be  counted  "an  army," 
whether  we  consider  their  numbers  or  their 
■valour ;  and  a  "  noble,  or  white-robed  army," 
Ibecause,  as  true  soldiers  of  Christ,  these 
Slave  fought  against  sin  with  their  lives  in 
their  hands,  and  were  "  slain  for  the  word 
of  God,"  and  "white  robes  were  given  to 
«ach  one  of  them"  (Rev.  vi.  9).     [H.] 

MARTYRDOM.  Tlie  death  of  a  martyr. 
The  same  name  is  sometimes  given  to  a 
Kjhurch  erected  over  the  spot  where  a  martyr 
Bias  suffered. 

MARTYRS,  FESTIVAL  OF  ALL 
i{See  All  Saints). 

MARTYROLOGY.  A  catalogue  or  list 
■of  martyrs,  including  the  history  of  their 
lives  and  sufferings  for  the  sake  of  reUgion. 


MAETYEOLOGY 

Days  of  commemoration  of  martyrs  were 
very  early  held,  as  may  be  seen  in  a  passage 
in  the  letter  of  the  Church  at  Smyrna  to 
the  Church  of  Philomelium,  on  the  occasion 
of  the  martyrdom  of  St.  Polycarp  (ckc. 
168).  "  So  we,  having  taken  his  bones  .  .  . 
out  of  the  fire,  laid  them  to  rest  in  a  suitable 
place.  There,  as  far  as  possible,  assembling 
with  exultation  and  joy,  we  shall  by  God's 
permission  keep  the  birthday  of  his  martyr- 
dom, both  for  the  memory  of  those  who 
have  already  fought  the  fight,  and  for  the 
training  and  preparation  of  those  that  are  to 
come  "  (c.  xviii.  ap.  Euseb.  iv.  15).  Such 
days  of  commemoration  and  edification  are 
frequently  mentioned  by  the  Fathers,  and 
according  to  the  usual  style,  the  day  of  his 
martyrdom  was  called  the  martyr's  birthday 
(Tertull.  de  Cor.  Mil.  cap.  3) ;  for,  as  St. 
Chrysostom  says,  the  death  of  a  martyr  is 
not  properly  a  death,  but  an  endless  life 
(Horn.  3  de  Bom.  Mart.).  The  solemnities 
were  at  first  celebrated  at  the  graves  of  the 
martyrs,  and  afterwards  in  churches  which 
were  built  over  the  graves,  and  often  called 
Martyries  (fuipTvpia).  In  early  times  we 
read  that  there  were  often  lists  of  martyrs ; 
and  Churches  had  distinct  festivals  of  their 
own  particular  martyrs,  ISiai  iravijyvpeis 
fuipTvpaiv :  to  which  Tertullian  also  refers, 
"  habeo  tuos  census,  tuos  fastos."- — Soz.  H. 
E.  V.  c.  3;  Tertull.  de  Cor.  Mil.  c.  13; 
Cypr.  Ep.  xxxvii.,  al.  12. 

At  these  commemorations  or  birthdays, 
the  deeds  and  sufferings  of  the  martyr  were 
recounted  or  read ;  and  that  this  soon  be- 
came an  established  custom  is  evident  from 
the  third  CouncU  of  Carthage  allowing  the 
"  passiones  martyrum "  to  be  read  as  well 
as  the  canonical  Scriptures  (Can.  47) ;  and 
St.  Augustine,  Gelasius,  and  others,  often 
mention  the  reading  of  such  histories  in  the 
African  and  Roman  churches.  The  col- 
lections of  the  "  passiones  martyrum,"  or 
Martyrologies,  were  doubtless  very  numer- 
ous, and  varied  in  the  different  churches ; 
but  there  were  one  or  two  into  which  the 
smaller  ones  were  absorbed.  Such  was  the 
Syrian  Martyrology,  of  which  a  copy  is 
extant,  ^vritten  a.d.  412.  It  was  discovered 
by  Dr.  Wright,  and  a  copy  published  by 
him  in  the  Journal  of  Sacred  Literature, 
vol.  viii.  p.  45 ;  London,  1866  (See  Diet. 
Clirist.  Ant.  ii.  1134).  Also  the  Hierony- 
mian  Martyrology,  mentioned  by  Gregory  the 
Great,  which  probably  contained  the  ancient 
Martyrologies  of  Eusebius  and  Jerome,  the 
lesser  Roman  Martyrology,  and  the  Martyr- 
ology of  Bede  in  the  eighth  century,  one  in 
prose,  the  other  in  verse.  The  last  three 
are  the  sources  of  almost  all  Western 
Martyrologies  and  Calendars,  as  may  be  seen 
upon  comparison. 

Florus,   deacon  of  Lyons,  in  the  ninth 


MAKT1E0L0GY 

century,  enlarged  Bede's  "  Martyrology,"  and 
put  it  almost  in  the  condition  it  is  in  at 
present.  Valdelbertus,  a  monk  of  the 
diocese  of  Treves,  in  the  same  century, 
wrote  a  Martyrology  in  verse,  extracted 
from  Bede  and  Floras,  which  is  given  in 
Dacherius's  SpicUegium.  About  the  same 
time,  Babanus  Maurus,  archbishop  of 
Mainz,  drew  up  a  Martyrology,  published 
by  Canisius,  in  his  Antiqux  Lectiones. 
After  these,  Ado,  archbishop  of  Vienne, 
compiled  a  new  Martyrology,  while  he  was 
travelling  in  Italy,  where,  in  a  journey  from 
Home  to  Ravenna  a.d.  857,  he  saw  a 
manuscript  of  an  ancient  Martyrology, 
which  had  been  brought  thither  from 
Aquileia.  This  was  the  lesser  Roman 
Martyrology  referred  to  above. 

In  the  year  870,  TJsuardus,  a  monk  of  St. 
Germain  des  Pres,  drew  up  a  much  larger 
and  more  correct  Martyrology  than  those 
above  mentioned.  This  work  was  well 
received,  and  soon  began  to  be  made  use  of 
in  the  offices  of  the  Western  Church.  About 
the  beginning  of  the  next  century,  Notkerus, 
a  monk  of  Switzerland,  drew  up  another 
Martyrology  from  Ado's  materials.  This 
Martyrology,  published  by  Canisius,  had  not 
the  same  success  with  that  of  Usuardus. 
The  churches  and  monasteries,  which  used 
this  last,  made  a  great  many  additions  and 
alterations  in  it.  This  gave  rise  to  a  vast 
number  of  different  Martyrologies  during 
the  six  following  centuries. 

At  last,  it  seemed  necessary  to  rectify  the 
errors  and  defects  of  the  old  Martyrologies, 
and  to  compile  new  ones.  Augustinus 
Belinus,  of  Padua,  began  this  reform  in  the 
fifteenth  century.  After  him,  Francis 
Maruli  or  Maurolycus,  abbot  of  Messina,  in 
Sicily,  drew  up  a  Martyrology,  in  which  he 
has  entirely  changed  Usuardus's  text.  John 
Vander  Meulen,  known  by  the  name  of 
Molanus,  a  doctor  of  Louvain,  restored  it, 
with  alterations  and  very  learned  notes. 
About  the  same  time,  Galesinus,  apostolic 
protonotary,  drew  up  a  Martyrology,  and 
dedicated  it  to  Gregory  XIII. ;  but  this  was 
not  approved  at  Kome.  Baronius'  "Mar- 
tyrology," written  some  time  after,  with 
notes,  was  better  received,  being  approved 
by  Pope  Sixtus  Quintus,  and  has  since 
passed  for  the  modem  Martyrology  of  the 
Eoman  Church.  It  has  been  several  times 
corrected,  and  was  translated  into  French 
by  the  Abbot  Chatlain,  canon  of  Notre- 
Dame  at  Paris,  with  notes,  in  the  year 
1709. 

An  English  Martyrology,  called  the 
"Golden  Legend,"  was  in  use  in  the  six- 
teenth century.  It  is  full  of  imaginary  and 
worse  than  useless  stories,  and  was  with 
other  Martyrologies  suppressed  at  the  Re- 
formation.— Cave,   Hist.   Lit.   ii.    Dis.   ii. ; 


MASS 


47T 


Bingham,  xx.  C  ;  Migne,  Patrol,  xciv.  799  ; 
Do  Rossi,  Eoma  Sotteran. ;  Blunt's  Diet. 
Doct. ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.     [H.] 

MARY  (See  Virgin  Mary ;  Mariolatry). 

MASOEAH— nnop.  A  term  in  Jewish 
theology,  signifying  tradition.  It  includes- 
notes  of  all  the  variations  of  words,  letters,  and 
points  which  occur  in  the  Hebrew  Scriptures ; 
an  enumeration  of  all  the  letters,  &c. ;  in, 
short,  the  minutest  points  of  verbal  criticism, 
and  pretends  to  an  immaculate  accuracy.  The 
authors  of  it  are  unknown.  Some  attribute- 
it  to  Moses ;  others  to  Ezra ;  others  to  the- 
Masorites  of  Tiberias.  The  probability  is, 
according  to  Bishop  AValton,  that  the  Masorah 
was  begun  about  the  time  of  the  Maccabees, 
and  was  continued  for  many  ages.  It  did 
not  meet  with  universal  approval  among- 
the  Jews,  of  whom  some  regretted  the  con- 
sequent cessation  of  oral  traditions.  Se& 
Bishop  Walton's  Prolegomena  to  his  Poly- 
glott  Bible. 

MASORITES.  A  society  of  learned 
Jews,  who  had  a  school  or  college  at 
Tiberias.  They  paid  great  attention  to  the 
critical  study  of  the  Hebrew  Scriptures ; 
and  to  them  by  many  able  scholars,  as- 
"Walton,  Capellus,  &c.,  is  attributed  the  in- 
vention of  the  vowel  points  now  used  for  the 
guidance  of  the  pronunciation  in  reading 
Hebrew. 

MASS.  I.  There  have  been  many  opinions 
with  regard  to  the  origin  of  this  word.  It 
has  been  connected  with  the  Hebrew  nSD 
missah,  an  oblation,  also  -svith  the  old  English 
msesse,  a  feast;  Italian  messa,  French  mes,  a 
course  of  dishes,  Spanish  mesa,  fare.  But 
there  would  seem  little  doubt  that  it  was  a  cor- 
ruption of  "  missa,"  which  originally  meant 
the  dismissal  of  the  congregation.  Cardinal 
Bona  says  that  the  word  is  derived  from  the 
"  Ite  missa  est,"  equivalent  to  "  let  us 
depart  in  peace,"  which  was  called  out  by 
the  deacon  at  the  end  of  the  service.  It  is  of 
great  antiquity,  occurring  in  a  letter  of  St^ 
Ambrose  to  his  sister :  "  Ego  mansi  in 
munere,  missam  facere  coepi,  dum  ofifero,. 
raptum  cognovi"  (Ep.  xxxiii.).  It  implied 
in  the  first  place  any  service — the  reading 
of  lessons,  or  offering  of  collects — but  gene- 
rally the  dismission  after  the  ser-vice ;  for 
missa.  and  the  later  Latin  missio  are  equiva- 
lent. It  was  not  for  some  time  that  the 
word  missa  became  associated  solely  with 
the  office  of  the  holy  Eucharist,  for  the 
missa  cateehumenorum  was  the  first  part  of" 
Divine  service  to  which  all  orders  of  men 
were  admitted.  Thus  it  was  ordered  by  the 
fourth  Council  of  Carthage  "  ut  episcopus 
nullum  prohibeat  ingredi  ecclesiam,  et  audire 
verbum  Dei,  sive  Gentilum,  sive  hajreticum, 
(fee,  usque  ad  missam  cateehumenorum"' 
(Can.   84).      The    daily   offices   were    also- 


478 


MASS 


sometimes  called  "missa3"  (^Conc.  Agathens. 
c.  30,  A.D.  500).  But  tlie  missa  fidelium,  a 
term  which  was  not  used  for  the  first  nine 
-centuries,  referred  only  to  the  celebration  of 
ithe  Eucharist.  As  the  word  missa  had 
"become  identical  with  "  service  "  in  the  case 
•of  the  catechumens,  it  would  naturally 
when  joined  with  "fidelium"  refer  to  the 
highest  service  to  which  the  former  could 
not  be  admitted.  But  other  explanations 
ihave  been  given,  as, "  Tunc  demum  adiacono 
•dicitur.  lie,  missa  est,  id  est,  ite  cum  pace 
in  domes  vestras,  quia  transmissa  est  pro 
-vobis  oratio  ad  Dominum;  et  per  angelos, 
■qui  nuntii  dicuntur,  allata  est  in  Diviuas 
■conspectum  Majestatis"  {Expos.  Miss,  ex 
veiust.  Cod.  in  Hittorp.  587).  The  term 
tmissa  sacramentorum  is  often  used,  but  not 
•earlier  than  the  eleventh  century.  (Bona, 
Rer.  Lit.  ii.,  viii.).  Bona  also  mentions  "  Holy 
■Communion "  as  an  ancient  name  for  the 
missa  (On  the  differences  between  the 
Eoman.  the  Milanese,  the  Gallioan,  and  the 
Mozarabic  Missas,  see  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  ii. 
1196). 

II.  As  on  the  Continent,  so  in  England 
there  were  different  forms  of  the  Liturgy, 
"but  the  most  widely  used  was  that  revised 
lay  Osmund,  bishop  of  Salisbury — the  St. 
•Gregory  of  England — in  1085.  Other  "  uses  " 
remained  (see  Use),  but  that  of  Sarum  was 
■most  generally  used ;  of  which  there  were 
several  editions ;  that  in  1541  being  adopted 
"by  the  Convocation  as  the  Breviary  for  that 
•time.  In  it,  as  in  the  others,  the  "'  Canon  op 
■THE  Mass  "  was  introduced  by  the  apostolic 
-versioles,  the  proper  preface,  and  the  Ter- 
•sanotus ;  after  this  there  was  a  long  prayer, 
interspersed  with  many  ceremonies,  but 
substantially  equivalent  to  the  "  Prayer  for 
the  Church  Militant,"  the  "Consecration 
Prayer,"  and  the  1st  "Thanksgiving  Prayer" 
of  our  office.  The  Pra^yer  of  Consecration 
•■was  not  immediately  followed  by  the  Par- 
-ticipation,  as  in  our  Liturgy ;  first  came  the 
Lord's  Prayer,  preceded  by  a  short  preface, 
and  followed  by  a  prayer  for  deliverance 
from  all  evil  :  then  the  "  Agnus  Dei "  sung 
•thrice :  then  the  commixture  of  the  sacred 
•elements  by  placing  a  portion  of  the  wafer 
into  the  chaKce :  then  the  kiss  of  peace, 
private  prayers  by  the  celebrant,  and  the 
prayer  of  humble  access :  then  the  Com- 
munion. The  service  ended  ■\7itli  a  thanks- 
giving prayer,  and  a  post-Communion  collect ; 
Ijut  afterwards  there  were  certain  ceremonies 
such  as  the  ablution  of  the  sacred  vessels, 
&c.  The  title  of  the  office  in  the  P.  B.  of 
1549  was,  "The  Supper  of  the  Lord,  and 
the  Holy  Communion,  commonly  called  the 
Mass."  The  latter  name,  however,  dropped 
out  of  use  after  the  introduction  of  the 
vernacular  into  Divine  Service  (See  Missa 
Sicca;  Presanctified).     [H.] 


MASTEK 

MASS,  SACRIFICE  OP  (See  Sacrifice). 

MASTER.  The  designation  of  some  of 
the  heads  of  colleges  at  Oxford,  and  of  all 
at  Cambridge  with  the  exception  of  two,  the 
Provost  of  King's  and  the  President  of 
Queen's.  The  _  heads  of  some  ancient  hos- 
pitals, as  Sherburn,  are  so  called.  It  is 
recognised  by  the  42nd  and  43rd  Canons, 
&c.,  as  one  of  the  names  of  governors  of 
cathedral  and  collegiate  churches. 

MASTER  OP  ARTS.  The  highest  de- 
gree in  arts,  signifying  one  who  is  com- 
petent to  teach,  answering  to  that  of  Doctor 
in  other  faculties;  conferred  in  all  \miver- 
sities,  though  in  a  few  modern  instances 
superseded  by  that  of  Doctor  of  Philosophy. 
In  England,  the  Masters  of  Arts  form  the 
privileged  body  of  the  ancient  universities 
there ;  and  there  are  many  offices  in  the 
Church  to  which  none  are  eligible  but  those 
who  have  at  least  taken  that  degree.  By 
Canon  128,  surrogates  must  be  M.A.  at 
least ;  and  by  Canon  74,  Masters  of  Arts 
being  beneficed,  are  enjoined  to  wear  hoods  or 
tippets  of  silk  or  sarcenet,  and  square  caps. 

MASTER  OP  THE  CEREMONIES. 
An  officer  in  many  foreign  cathedrals, 
whose  business  it  is  to  see  that  all  the  cere- 
monies, vestments,  &c.,  peculiar  to  each 
season  and  festival,  are  observed  in  the 
choir. 

MASTER  OP  THE  PACULTIES.  The 
priucipal  officer  of  the  Court  of  Paoulties. 
The  office  is  now  combined  with  that  of 
Dean  of  Arches,  by  the  Public  Worship  Act, 
1874. 

MASTER  OP  THE  SENTENCES.  The 
name  commonly  given  to  the  celebrated 
Peter  Lombard,  bishop  of  Paris,  one  of  the 
founders  of  scholastic  divinity;  so  called 
from  his  great  work  of  the  Sentences, 
divided  into  four  books,  illustrative  of  doc- 
trines of  the  Churches,  in  sentences,  or 
passages  taken  from  the  Pathers. — Dupin. 

MASTER  OP  THE  SONG.  A  name  for 
the  instructor  of  the  choristers,  or  choir- 

MASTER  OP  THE  TEMPLE.  The 
principal  minister  in  the  Temple  Church,  in 
London,  styled  also  the  Gustos  and  Rector ; 
who,  since  the  time  of  Henry  VIII.,  has 
been  appointed  by  royal  letters  patent, 
without  institution  or  induction.  This  is  a 
post  of  great  eminence,  and  has  been  held 
by  many  able  divines,  as  Hooker,  Bishop 
Sherlock,  &c.  The  salary  from  the  Crown 
is  only  about  £30 ;  the  rest  of  it,  and  also 
the  Master's  house,  are  provided  by  the  two 
societies  of  the  Temple.  The  preachers  of 
Lincoln's  Inn  and  Gray's  Inn  are  appointed 
by  the  Benchers.  Those  of  Lincoln's  Inn 
have  included  four  archbishops,  ten  bishops, 
and  two  celebrated  deans.  Dr.  Donne  and 
Cyril  Jackson.     [G.] 


MASTERS 

MASTERS  OF  THE  SCHOOLS.  Three 
Masters  of  Arts,  in  the  university  of  Oxford, 
annually  elected,  who  preside  over  certain 
exercises  of  under-gradnates.  Before  the 
Ancient  disputations  and  determinations  were 
:abolished,  tbeir  office  was  much  more  onerous 
than  at  present. 

MATINS,  or  MATTINS.  The  ancient 
name  for  early  morning  prayers,  which  were 
said  at  some  time  after  midnight.  "  Ante 
auroram  vel  ex  ortu  auroras." — Dugdale, 
Monast.  Any.  vi.  679. 

The  hours  of  prayer  in  the  Church  of 
England,  before  the  Reformation,  were  seven 
in  number,  viz.  matins,  the  first  or  prime, 
the  third,  sixth,  and  ninth  hours,  vespers 
and  compline.  The  office  of  matins,  or 
morning  prayer,  according  to  the  Church  of 
England,  is  a  judicious  abridgment  of  her 
ancient  services  for  matins,  lauds,  and 
prime. 

The  office  of  matins,  or  morning  prayer, 
according  to  the  English  ritual,  may  be 
•divided  into  three  principal  parts.  First, 
the  introduction,  which  extends  from  the 
beginning  of  the  office  to  the  end  of  the 
Lord's  Prayer ;  secondly,  the  psalmody 
and  reading,  which  extends  to  the  end  of 
the  Apostles'  Creed;  and,  thirdly,  the 
prayers  and  collects,  which  occupy  the  re- 
mainder of  the  service. — Palmer,  Orig. 
Liturg.  i.  213. 

MATREMONY  {Matrimoniam).  The 
muptial  state.  According  to  the  law  of 
England  marriage  may  be  regarded  merely 
as  a  civil  contract ;  and  so  far  as  the  effects 
of  the  law  are  concerned,  -those  who  con- 
tract marriage  by  a  merely  civil  ceremony 
undergo  no  disabilities,  and  are  regarded,  to 
ail  intents  and  purposes,  as  man  and  wife. 
But  from  the  earliest  ages  in  the  Church 
marriage  has  ever  been  solemnized  with 
religious  rites,  as  may  be  seen  from  the 
writings  of  the  Fathers,  and  the  decrees  of 
councils  (See  Marriage).  And  indeed  it 
has  been  regarded  as  a  sacrament  in  the 
Church  of  Rome,  which  bases  her  teaching 
upon  the  words  of  St.  Paul  (Eph.  v.  32), 
•"  this  is  a  great  mystery,"  which  is  rendered 
in  the  Vulgate  "  Sacramentum  hoc  magnum 
est."  The  Church  of  England  plainly 
declares  the  high  religious  significance  of 
the  rite  of  matrimony  :  it  is  "  instituted  of 
Ood ; "  it  signifies  "  the  mystical  union 
betwixt  Christ  and  His  Church ; "  it  is  to  be 
taken  in  hand  "  in  the  fear  of  God ; "  and 
■"  so  many  as  are  coupled  together  otherwise 
than  God's  word  doth  allow,  are  not  joined 
together  by  God." 

II.  (i.)  In  ancient  times  the  betrothal  and 
the  rite  of  matrimony  were  distinct,  the 
former  taking  place  often  years  before  the 
latter  (See  Betrothal).  The  service  for 
matrimony  itself  consisted  of  three  parts : 


MATTHEW,  ST. 


479 


(1)  prayers,  (2)  the  sacerdotal  benediction, 
(3)  the  oblation  of  the  Holy  Eucharist. 
There  were  several  minor  ceremonies  such 
as  veiling  the  bride,  crowning  the  bridal 
hair  with  garlands,  &c.,  some  of  which  are 
condemned  by  St.  Chrysostom  {Horn,  in 
1  Cor.).  The  present  English  form  of 
solemnization  of  matrimony  is  taken  in 
substance  from  the  old  office  in  the  Sarum 
Manual,  omitting  the  formal  benediction  of 
the  ring,  and  the  special  form  of  the  nuptial 
mass  immediately  following  the  service. 
Some  of  the  hortatory  parts  are  taken 
from  Hermann's  Consultatio.  There  has 
been  no  change  in  the  service  since  1549, 
except  the  omission  of  the  "  tokens  of 
sponsage,  as  gold  and  silver,"  presented 
with  the  ring;  and  the  alteration  of  the 
rubric  with  regard  to  the  Holy  Communion. 
This  at  the  Reformation  ran — "  The  new 
married  persons,  the  same  day  as  their 
marriage,  must  receive  the  Holy  Com- 
munion." In  1661,  to  satisfy  the  Puritans, 
it  was  changed  to  "  it  is  convenient,"  &c. 
In  this  the  Church  of  England  is  not  pe- 
culiar, for  in  the  Eastern  Church  the  newly- 
married  couple  are  not  obliged  to  receive  the 
sacrament  of  the  Eucharist  immediately  at 
the  time  of  marriage  (Goar,  Rit.  Graic.  Off. 
Cor.  Nupt.  p.  385).  The  possible  celebra- 
tion of  Holy  Communion,  the  fact  that  the 
benediction  is  pronounced,  and  the  ancient 
custom  of  the  Church,  would  imply  that 
the  service  should  properly  be  performed  by 
a  priest,  though  that  is  not  the  law  (See 
Deacon ;  Marriage^. 

(ii.)  On  account  of  the  accompanying 
festivity  marriage  was  early  prohibited  in 
Lent,  in  the  eleventh  century.  It  was  also 
forbidden  between  Advent  and  the  octave 
of  Epiphany ;  between  Septuagesima  and 
the  octave  of  Easter ;  during  fourteen  days 
before  the  feast  of  St.  John  Baptist ;  during 
the  Ember  weeks,  and  on  all  vigils.  An 
attempt  was  made  in  1661  to  restore  some 
of  these  restrictions,  but  it  was  not  success- 
ful. 

(iii.)  Notice  with  regard  to  an  intended 
marriage  was  always  required  beforehand 
by  the  Church.  The  earliest  allusion  to  this 
in  England  is  in  the  eleventh  canon  of  the 
Synod  of  "Westminster  (a.d.  1200),  which 
requires  banns  to  be  thrice  published  (See 
Banns).     [H.] 

MATTHEW,  ST.,  THE  EVANGE- 
LIST'S DAY.  A  festival  of  the  Christian 
Church,  observed  on  the  21st  of  September. 

St.  Matthew,  the  son  of  Alphajus,  was 
also  called  Levi.  He  was  of  Jewish  ori- 
gin, as  both  his  names  discover,  and  pro- 
bably a  Galilean.  Before  his  call  to  the 
apostolate,  he  was  a  publican  or  toll- 
gatherer  to  the  Romans;  an  office  of  bad 
repute  among  the  Jews,  on  account  of  the 


480 


MATTHEW'S,  ST. 


covetousness  and  exactions  of  those  wlio 
managed  it. 

St.  Matthew  continued  with  the  rest  of 
the  apostles  till  after  our  Lord's  ascension. 
According  to  tradition,  for  the  first  eight 
years  afterwards  he  preached  in  Judasa. 
Then  he  betook  liimself  to  propagating  the 
Gospel  among  the  Gentiles,  and  chose 
Ethiopia  as  the  scene  of  his  apostolical 
ministry:  where  it  is  said  he  suifered 
martyrdom,  hut  by  what  kind  of  death  is 
altogether  uncertain. 

MATTHEW'S,  ST.,  GOSPEL.  A  ca- 
nonical book  of  the  New  Testament  (See 
the  preceding  article). 

According  to  Papias  (quoted  b^'  Eusebius, 
iii.  39),  Irenajus  (iii.  1),  Grigen  {ap.  Euseb. 
vi.  25),  Eusebius  (iii.  24),  Jerome,  de  Vii. 
lllustr.,  and  others,  St.  Matthew  wrote  his 
Gospel  in  Hebrew,  Syro-Chaldaic,  or 
Aramajan,  which  was  afterwards  translated 
into  Greek,  but  by  whom  is  not  stated,  and 
the  accuracy  of  this  tradition  is  far  from 
being  clearly  established  (See  Professor 
Westcott,  Introd.  to  Shidy  of  the  Gospels, 
and  Professor  Salmon,  Introd.  to  New  Tes- 
tament). 

MATTHIAS',  ST.,  DAY:  observed  on 
Feb.  24.  St.  Matthias  was  probably  one  of 
the  seventy  disciples  (Clem.  Alex.  Strom. 
i.  4 ;  Euseb.  i.  1,  c.  12),  and  a  constant  at- 
tendant on  our  Saviour  during  His  ministry. 
For  this  reason  he  was  one  of  the  two  chosen 
to  fill  up  the  place  of  Judas  the  traitor,  the 
other  being  Joseph  called  Barsabas,  "  and 
the  lot  fell  upon  Matthias."  'i'here  is 
nothing  known  of  his  subsequent  labours  ; 
according  to  the  Greek  menologies  he  planted 
the  faith  about  Cappadocia,  and  received 
there  the  crown  of  martyrdom. 

The  observance  of  this  festival  was  for 
a  time  attended  with  some  confusion.  The 
Prayer  Book  of  Queen  EHzabeth  directs  that 
in  leap-years  an  additional  day  shall  be 
added  between  Feb.  23  and  24 :  hence  St. 
Matthias'  Day  in  leap-years  was  observed 
on  Feb.  25.  On  the  review  of  the  Liturgy 
it  was  thought  more  proper  to  add  a  29th 
day  to  February ;  so  that  the  festival  would 
naturally  always  keep  to  the  24th.  Never- 
theless mistakes  were  constantly  made  (es- 
pecially by  the  almanack  makers)  till  Arch- 
bishop Sancroft  in  1683  issued  an  injunction 
that  St.  Matthias'  Day  was  always  to  be 
obseiTed  on  Feb.  24. 

MAUNDY  THURSDAY  (Dies  Man- 
dafi).  The  Thursday  in  Holy  Week,  on 
which  day  our  Lord  gave  His  new  Com- 
mandment (St.  John  xiii.  38)  and  the 
sacrament  of  the  Holy  Eucharist  was  in- 
stituted :  it  was  therefore  called  also  Dies 
Cienie  Domini,  Dies  Natalis  Eucliaristicse, 
Dies  Natalis  Calicis,  Dies  raysteriorum,  &c. 
I.  There  were  several  ceremonials  connected 


MEANS  OF  GRACE 

with  it  in  the  early  and  medieval  Church, 
Penance  was  on  this  day  relaxed,  as  St. 
Ambrose  says,  "  dies  erat  quo  Dominus  sese 
pro  nobis  tradidit,  quo  in  ecclesia  pajnitenti- 
alia  relaxantur"  {Ep.  33).  And  sermons 
were  especially  addressed  to  penitents  (Mar- 
tene,  Eccl.  Bit.  1,  6),  hence  it  was  also 
called  dies  indulgentix ;  the  Eucharist  was 
celebrated  in  the  evening,  in  particular 
commemoration  of  its  iirst  institution  (Aug. 
Ep.  cxviii.  ad  Januar.),  but  this  was  after- 
wards discontinued,  and  prohibited  (Cone. 
Trull.  Can.  29) ;  the  catechumens  had  to 
repeat  their  creed  either  on  the  Thursday  or 
on  the  Saturday  (Martene,  i.  116,  lib.  i. 
0.  i. ;  Con.  Laod.  c.  46) ;  the  sacred  oil  was- 
consecrated  for  use  during  the  j'ear  (see 
Chrism'),  for  which  there  are  collects,  and 
a  missa  chrismalis  in  the  Gregorian  and 
Gelasiaa  sacramentaries,  and  for  which 
services  with  very  solemn  ritual  were  ap- 
pointed (Mm-atori,  Lit.  Rom.  Vet.  i.  554; 
ii.  991)  ;  the  altars  were  bared,  and  washed 
with  wine  and  water ;  and  the  feet  of  the 
choir  were  washed  by  the  clergy,  in  imi- 
tation of  the  action  of  our  Lord.  The  latter 
ceremony  was  enlarged  upon,  and  sovereigns, 
bishops  and  nobles,  used  to  wash  the  feet 
of  certain  poor, — as  the  pope  does  at  tho 
present  day  on  Maundy  Thursday. 

II.  In  the  Sarum  Missal  the  rubric  runs : 
"  Post  prandium  conveniant  clerici  ad  eccle- 
siam,  ad  altaria  abluenda ;  et  ad  mandatum 
faciendiim ;  et  ad  completorium  dicendum." 
While  the  mandatum,  pedilavium,  or  feet- 
washing  took  place,  the  antiphon  was  sung, 
"  Mandatum  novum  do  vobis  : "  from  the 
first  word  of  which  our  Maundy  or  Mandie 
(Bp.  Cosin)  is  derived,  not,  as  has  been 
supposed,  from  "maunds"  or  baskets  of 
gifts,  which  were  made  at  this  time  (See 
Bp.  Sparrow's  Rationale  on  the  Common 
Prayers,  p.  135).  In  the  Hierurgia  An- 
glicana  (p.  282)  an  account  is  given 
of  the  ceremonial  of  washing  the  feet 
of  the  poor  by  Queen  Elizabeth.  James 
II.  is  said  to  have  been  the  last  of  our 
sovereigns  who  performed  it.  It  is  still  the- 
custom  on  Maundy  Thursday  for  the  Lord 
High  Almoner  to  distribute  royal  gifts  of 
money,  woollen  and  linen  cloths,  shoes  and 
stockings,  to  certain  poor  in  the  Royal 
Chapel  at  Whitehall,  with  a  solemn  service. 
A  vestige  of  the  old  ceremony  is  retained  in 
this  service,  the  Almoner  and  his  assistant 
being  girded  with  long  linen  towels  during 
the  distribution  (For  the  service  on  this- 
occasion  see  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  i.  99). 

MEANS  OF  GRACE  (See  Ordinance 
and  Sacraments).  The  sacraments  and  other 
ordinances  of  the  Church  "through  whida 
grace  is  conveyed  to  souls  prepared  by  faith 
and  penitence  to  receive  it.  The  expression 
is  used  once  in  the  Prayer  Book,  in  the 


MEDIAXOK 

■"  Greneral  Thanksgiving  " — "  fortlie  means  of 
gi'ace,  and  for  tlie  hope  of  glory." 

MEDIATOR  (See  Jesus,  Lord,  Christ, 
MessiaJi).  A  person  who  intervenes  between 
two  parties  at  variance.  Thus  our  Blessed 
Lord  and  Saviour  Jesus  Christ  is  the  Me- 
diator between  Gcod  and  man. 

This  appears  from  1  'Hm.  ii.  5,  "For 
there  is  one  God,  and  one  Mediator  between 
Grod  and  men,  the  man  Christ  Jesus." 
When  we  call  Him  a  Mediator,  we  call  Him 
so,  not  only  as  He  is  our  Redeemer,  but  also  as 
He  is  our  Intercessor.  "  For,  if  any  man  sin, 
we  have  an  advocate  with  the  Father,  Jesus 
Ohrist,  the  righteous "  (1  St.  John  ii.  1). 
It  is  to  be  remembp.red  however,  that  by  a 
mediator  here  the  Church  means,  not  bare]}' 
an  intercessor  or  transactor  of  business  be- 
xween  two  parties,  in  which  sense  Moses 
was  a  mediator  between  God  and  the 
Israelites  with  respect  to  the  ceremonial 
law,  or  St.  John  Baptist  as  between  the 
Old  and  New  Testament  (Greg.  Naz.  Orat. 
xxxiv.),  or  Christian  priests  as  merely  in- 
ternuncil,  or  media  of  communication,  in 
which  sense  the  word  is  often  used  by  the 
Fathers,  and  which  is  given  to  them  in  the 
Apostolic  Constitutions  (ii.  25 ;  Bingham,  ii. 
xix.  16) ;  but  such  a  Mediator,  Intercessor, 
and  Transactor,  as  can  plead  the  merit  of  His 
own  blood,  offered  up  in  man's  stead,  to 
Teconcile  an  offended  GckI  to  sinful  man. 
In  this  sense  Christ  is  the  mediator  between 
•God  and  man,  being  both  God  and  man. 
And  He  is  represented,  boih  in  the  Old  and 
New  Testament,  as  the  only  Redeemer  of 
mankind,  as  the  only  sacrifice  for  the  sins 
of  the  whole  world,  and  the  only  Mediator 
between  God  and  man. — Suicer,  s.  v.  ixfo-trrjs. 

MELCHITES.  Tlie  name  which  is 
given  to  the  Syriac,  Egyptian,  and  other 
Christians  of  the  Levant ;  who,  though  not 
Greeks,  follow  the  doctrines  and  ceremonies 
of  the  Greek  Church,  and  submit  to  the 
decisions  of  the  Council  of  Chalcedon.  The 
term  Melchites  is  borrowed  from  the  Hebrew 

•or  Aramaic  word  ^?D,  Melee,  which  signifies 
to  reign.  So  that  Melchites  is  as  much  as 
to  say  Royalists,  and  is  a  term  of  reproach, 
given  to  the  orthodox  by  the  Eutychians,  or 
■Jacobites,  on  account  of  their  implicit  sub- 
mission to  the  edicts  of  the  emperors,  for 
the  publication  and  reception  of  the  above- 
mentioned  council. 

The  Melchites,  excepting  some  few  points 
■of  little  or  no  importance,  which  relate  only 
to  their  ceremonies  and  ecclesiastical  dis- 
cipline, are  in  every  respect  professed  Greeks. 
They  have  translations,  in  the  Arabic 
language,  of  the  Greek  rituals ;  but  their 
versions  are  for  the  most  part  very  incorrect. 
In  general,  the  Christians  of  the  Levant  are 
ao  far  from  being  just  and  correct  in  their 


JtELETIANS 


481 


translations  of  the  Greek  authors,  that  they 
imagine  they  have  a  right  to  make  them 
speak  according  to  their  own  sentiments. 
This  is  evident  in  the  Arabic  canons  of  the 
Council  of  Nice,  in  which  the  Melchites  find 
sufiicient  arguments  to  justify  their  notions 
against  those  of  the  Jacobites;  and  the 
Jacobites,  on  the  other  hand,  by  the  very 
same  canons,  vindicate  their  tenets  against 
those  of  the  Melchites. 

The  Melchites  are  governed  by  a  parti- 
cular patriarch,  who  resides  at  Damascus, 
and  assumes  the  title  of  Patriarch  of 
Antioch.  The  great  difficulty  they  meet 
with  in  finding  such  ministers  as  can  read 
Greek,  is  said  to  be  the  true  reason  why 
they  celebrate  mass  in  the  Arabic  lan- 
guage :  and  even  those  who  are  acquainted 
with  the  Greek  tongue,  yet  read  the  Epistle 
and  Gospel  in  Arabic. 

The  monks  among  the  Melchites  follow 
the  rule  of  St.  Basil,  the  common  rule  of 
all  the  Greek  monks.  They  have  four  fine 
convents,  distant  about  a  daj^'s  journey  from 
Damascus.  They  never  go  out  of  the 
cloister. — Stubbs'  Soames'  Moslieim,  i.  429 ; 
iii.  .567. 

MELETIANS.  There  were  in  the  4th 
century  two  schisms  called  Mehtian. 

I.  The  Meletians  of  Egypt  had  their 
name  from  Meletius,  a  bishop  of  Lycopolis, 
the  second  of  the  Egyptian  sees  in  dignity. 
It  has  been  most  commonly  supposed  that 
Meletius  sacrificed  to  the  heathen  gods  in  a 
persecution  about  the  year  301,  or  perhaps 
in  the  last  general  persecution  a  few  years 
later.  But  there  seems  to  be  reason  for 
supposing  that  the  occasion  of  his  schism 
was  of  an  opposite  kind — that  he  objected 
to  the  lenity  with  which  Peter,  bishop  of 
Alexandria,  treated  those  who  had  lapsed 
in  the  persecution;  and  this  explanation 
agrees  better  with  the  character  of  the  sect, 
who  rejected  all  from  their  communion,  who 
in  time  of  persecution  fell  from  Christ, 
though  they  afterwards  repented.  Meletius 
proceeded  to  ordain  bishops,  and  at  one 
time  had  nearly  thirty  of  these  in  his 
communion.  He  was  prohibited  for  ever  to 
ordain  by  the  Council  of  Nice,  but  his  fol- 
lowers were  admitted  to  communion  with- 
out re-ordination.  He  submitted  to  this  at 
first,  but  afterwards  resumed  his  practice  of 
schismatical  ordinations.  The  Arians  at- 
tempted to  draw  the  Meletians  into  a  con- 
nexion with  them,  on  the  ground  of  their 
common  enmity  to  the  orthodox  bishops  of 
Alexandria;  and  thus  the  schismatics, 
whose  original  difference  with  the  Church 
had  been  limited  to  questions  of  discipline, 
became  infected  with  heresy. 

II.  The  Meletians  of  Antioch  were  so 
called  from  Meletius,  who  in  360  was 
appointed   to   the    bishopric    of  that  city. 

2  I 


482 


MEMOEI^ 


Altliougli  he  owed  his  appointment  to  the 
Arians,  he  soon  showed  that  lie  was  ortho- 
dox; whereupon  he  was  deposed  and 
banished.  He  afterwards  recovered  his  see, 
but  the  adherents  of  Eustathius,  wlio  had 
been  deposed  by  the  Arians  many  years 
before,  refused  to  communicate  with  him ; 
and  Lucifer,  bishop  of  Cagliari,  by  ordaining 
PaJulinus  in  opposition  to  him,  contributed 
to  exasperate  the  differences  of  the  ortho- 
dox. The  schism  of  Antioch  was  not  finally 
healed  until  the  year  415.' — ^Stubbs'  Soames' 
Mosheim,  i.  276,  aOO ;  Stephens'  St.  Chry- 
sosiom,  pp.  19-31. 

MEMOBIiE  COMMUNES.  CoUects  of 
which  there  are  several  pages  in  the  Salisbury 
Missal,  which  correspond  to  "Prayers  and 
Thanksgivings  on  several  occasions."  The 
four  intercessory  prayers  now  used  in  the 
morning  and  evening  service  immediately 
after  the  Anthem  seem  to  have  been  origi- 
nally considered  as  belonghig  to  this  class. 
The  original  ideas,  though  not  the  ipsissima 
verba  of  these  four  prayers,  and  several  of 
those  called  "  Occasional,"  are  to  be  found 
in  the  Memoriie  Communes. — ^Blunt's  Annot. 
P.  B.  i.  26.     [H.] 

MEMORIAL  COLLECT.  AVhen  two 
holy  days  coincide  the  collect  of  the  lesser 
one  is  used  after  that  of  the  greater,  by  way 
of  commemoration — hence  called  the  me- 
morial collect.     [H.] 

MENiEA,orMENAIA(TA/i7)i/am).  The 
name  which  the  Greeks  give  to  the  twelve 
volumes  of  their  Church  Service.  These 
volumes  answer  to  the  twelve  months  in  the 
year,  each  volume  taking  in  a  month.  In 
this  book  are  contained  the  offices  for  the 
saints  of  every  day,  methodically  digested. 

From  the  Menaion  is  drawn  the  Meno- 
logium  (Menology),  or  Greek  calendar,  in 
which  the  lives  of  the  saints  in  short,  or 
their  names  only,  are  cited.  The  Menaion, 
therefore,  of  the  Greek  answers  to  the 
Breviary  of  the  Latins,  and  the  Menology 
to  the  Martyrology  (See  Breviary  and  Mar- 
tyrology). — Neale's  Eastern  Church,  829. 

MENDICANTS,  or  BEGGING  PRIAES. 
There  are  several  orders  of  monks  or  friars, 
in  Popish  countries,  who,  having  no  income 
or  revenues,  are  supported  by  the  charitable 
contributions  of  others.  These,  from  their 
manner  of  life,  are  called  Mendicants. 

This  sort  of  friars  began  in  the  thirteenth 
century,  when  Dominic  de  Guzman,  with 
nine  more  of  his  companions,  foimded  the 
order  of  Preacliing  Friars,  called  from 
their  founder  Dominicans.  The  other  three 
Mendicant  orders  are,  the  Franciscans, 
Auyustines,  and  Carmelites. 

Tbe  friars  did  much  good  and  effected 
many  reforms.  They  were,  indeed,  the  chief 
missionaries  of  the  age.  But  with  their 
success    and    prosperity   came    corruption. 


MENNONITES 

They  set  altar  against  altar,  and  delighted 
in  turning  the  parish  priest  into  ridicule. 
They  gave  great  disturbance  to  the  secular 
clergy,  by  pretending  to  a  right  of  taking 
confessions  and  granting  absolution,  with- 
out asking  leave  of  the  parochial  priests, 
or  even  the  bishops  themselves.  Pope 
Innocent  IV.  restrained  this  licence,  and 
prohibited  the  Mendicants  from  confess- 
ing the  faithful  without  leave  of  the  cure. 
Alexander  IV.  restored  this  privilege  to 
them.  And  Martin  IV.,  to  accommodate 
the  dispute,  granted  them  a  permission  to- 
receive  confessions,  upon  condition  that  the 
penitents  who  applied  to  them  should  con- 
fess once  a  year  to  their  proper  pastor. 
However,  this  expedient  falling  short  of  full 
satisfaction,  Boniface  VIII.  ordered  that  the 
superiors  of  religious  houses  should  make 
application  to  the  bishops  for  their  permis- 
sion to  such  friars  as  should  be  commissioned 
by  their  respective  abbots  to  administer  tli* 
sacrament  of  penance.  But  by  Alexander  V. 
they  were  invested  with  authority  to  receive 
confession,  and  to  give  absolution  in  everj^ 
parish  in  every  part  of  the  world.  They 
were,  of  course,  everywhere  the  advocates  of 
the  pope,  and  enemies  to  the  independence 
of  the  Church  of  England.  It  was  by  his 
fearless  attack  with  regard  to  the  Mendicant 
Friars  that  Wiclif  rose  into  fame  and  popu- 
larity at  Oxford. — ^Milman's  Lat.  Christ,  v. 
461,  488 ;  Hook's  Archbishops,  iii.  48. 

MENGRELIANS.  Christians  of  the 
Greek  religion,  converted  by  Cyrillus  and 
Methodius.  They  baptize  not  their  children 
till  the  eighth  year,  and  enter  not  into  the 
Church  (the  men  especially)  till  the  sixtieth 
(others  say  the  fortieth)  year,  but  hear 
Divine  service  standing  without  the  temple. 

MENNONITES.  A  sect  of  Anabaptists- 
in  Holland,  so  denominated  from  one 
Mennon  Simonis  of  Frisia,  who  lived  in  the 
sixteenth  century.  The  Protestants,  as- 
well  as  the  Romanists,  confuted  them. 
Mennon  was  not  the  first  of  the  Anabaptists  ; 
but  having  rejected  the  enthusiasms  and 
revelations  of  the  first  Anabaptists  and 
their  opinions  concerning  the  new  kingdom 
of  Jesus  Christ,  he  set  up  other  tenets,, 
which  his  followers  hold  to  this  ti.me.  They 
believe  that  the  New  Testament  is  the  only 
rule  of  our  faith  ;  that  the  terms  Person  and 
Trinity  are  not  to  be  used  in  speaking  of 
the  Father,  Son,  and  Holy  Ghost ;  that  the 
first  men  were  not  created  just ;  that  there 
is  no  original  sin ;  that  Jesus  Christ  had  not 
His  flesh  from  the  substance  of  His  mother 
Mary,  but  from  the  essence  of  His  Father ; 
that  it  is  not  lawful  for  Christians  to  swear, 
or  exercise  any  ofSce  of  magistracy,  nor  use 
the  sword  to  punish  evil-doers,  nor  to 
wage  war  upon  any  terms  ;  that  a  Christian 
may  attain  to  the  height  of  perfection  in 


MENOLOGY 

tliis  life;  that  the  ministers  of  the  gospel 
ought  not  to  receive  any  salary;  that 
children  are  not  to  be  baptized;  that  the 
souls  of  men  after  death  rest  in  an  unknown 
place. 

In  the  meantime  these  Mennonites  broke 
into  several  divisions,  for  very  inconsiderable 
reasons;  many  among  them  embraced  the 
opinions  of  the  Socinians,  or  rather  of  the 
Arians,  touching  the  Deity  of  Christ ;  and 
they  were  all  for  moderation  in  religion,  not 
thinking  that  they  might  lawfully  debar 
from  their  assemblies  any  man  leading  a 
pious  life,  and  that  owned  the  Scriptures  for 
the  Word  of  God.  These  were  called 
Gralenites,  and  borrowed  their  name  from  a 
physician  of  Amsterdam,  called  Galen. 
Some  of  them  in  Holland  are  called  Col- 
legiates,  because  they  meet  privately,  and 
every  one  in  their  assembly  has  the  liberty 
to  speak,  to  expound  the  Scriptures,  to 
pray,  and  to  sing:  they  that  are  truly 
Collegiates  are  Trinitarians :  they  never 
receive  the  communion  in  their  college,  but 
they  meet  twice  a  year,  from  all  parts  of 
Holland,  at  Khinsburg,  a  village  about  two 
leagues  from  Leyden;  there  they  receive 
the  sacrament.  The  first  that  sits  at 
table  may  distribute  it  to  the  rest ;  and  all 
sects  are  admitted,  even  the  Roman  Catho- 
lics, if  they  would  come  (See  Stubbs' 
Soames'  MosJieim,  iii.  136, 146,  148, 152). 

MENOLOGy  (jir,vo\6yi.ov).  A  book 
corresponding  with  the  Latin  Martyrology. 
Fragments  of  menologia  of  the  eighth  or 
ninth  century  are  published  at  the  end  of 
Scholz'  Oreeh  Test,  1830.  In  modern  usage 
the  word  has  sometimes  been  confounded 
with  the  Menajon. — Ooar.  Not.  29  in  Lavd. 
Off.  (See  Martyrology ;  Menseori).     [H.] 

MENSA.  The  slab  of  stone  or  wood  used 
as  the  surface  of  the  Altar  or  Lord's  Table. 
Stone  has  been  decided  illegal,  both  for  the 
mensa  and  the  table  (see  Altar"),  "  though 
as  neither  the  stone  table  nor  the  wooden 
one  is  ever  seen  when  it  is  used,  being 
always  covered;  nor  is  a  wooden  one  in 
fact  ever  moved,  or  wanted  to  be  moved, 
any  more  than  a  stone  one ;  and  as  stone  or 
marble  tables  .  .  .  had  long  been  used  in 
churches  ...  it  is  pretty  evident  that  the 
sudden  outcry  against  stone  tables  had  a 
good  deal  more  to  do  with  Odium  Theo- 
logium  than  with  religion." — Lectures  on 
Church  Building,  Sir  E.  Beckett,  p.  247, 
1856.     [H.] 

MESSALIANS,  or  MASSALIANS.  So 
called  from  a  Chaldee  word,  which  signifies 
to  pray,  as  does  the  Greek  evxo/iai,  from 
which  these  sectaries  had  also  the  name  of 
Euchites,  because  they  prayed  continually, 
and  held  nothing  necessary  to  salvation 
but  prayer :  they  rejected  preaching  and  the 
sacraments:    they  held  that  the  supreme 


METHODISTS 


483 


God  was  visible :  and  that  Satan  was  to  be 
worshipped  that  he  might  do  no  hurt :  they 
pretended  to  cast  out  devils;  and  rejected 
almsgiving.  This  heresy  prevailed  under 
Valentinian  and  Valens,  about  a.d.  370. 

MESSIAH,  n^B'p ;  equivalent  to  xpioroj, 
the  Anointed  (see  Christ,  Jesus,  and  Lord). 
It  is  the  title  given  by  way  of  eminence  to 
our  Blessed  Saviour,  and  it  alludes  to 
the  authority  He  possesses  to  assume  the 
characters  of  Prophet,  Priest,  and  King,  and 
so  of  the  Saviour  of  the  world. 

Christ  the  Messiah  was  promised  by  God 
(Gen.  iii.  15 ;  xxi.  12),  and  foretold  by  the 
prophets  (Gen.  slix.  10 ;  1  Sam.  ii.  10  and 
35  ;  Ps.  ii.  2 ;  xlv.  7 ;  Micah  v.  2,  with  St. 
John  vii.  42 ;  Mai.  iii.  1),  as  the  "  redeemer  " 
of  Israel  (Job  xix.  25 ;  Isa.  lix.  20 ;  St.  Luke 
xxiv.  21),  and  "  the  desire  of  all  nations " 
(Haggai  ii.  7).  He  who  was  born  in  the  days 
of  Herod,  of  a  pure  virgin,  and  called  "Jesus," 
according  to  prophecy  (St.  Luke  i.  31),  is 
that  "Messiah,"  "the  Christ"  (St.  John  L 
41 ;  Acts  ii.  36),  as  He  declares  himself  to  be 
(St.  John  X.  24, 25),  whose  coming  was  then 
expected  (St.  Matt.  ii.  1,  2 ;  St.  John  iv.  25, 
29, 42).  Who  was  "  anointed,"  not  with  any 
material  and  typifying  "  oil,"  as  were  those 
who  preceded  Him — His  types — ^but  with 
"  the  Spirit  of  God  "  (St.  Matt.  iii.  16  ;  St. 
John  i.  32,  33),  "  the  Spirit  of  the  Lord,"  as 
promised  (Isa.  xi.  2 ;  xlii.  1 ;  St.  Matt.  xii.  18), 
a  spiritual  unction — "  the  oil  of  gladness, 
above  his  fellows  "  (Ps.  xlv.  7) ;  and  thus 
was  He  consecrated  to  the  three  oflSces, 
divided  in  others,  being  the  great  Prophet 
predicted  (Deut.  xviii.  15,  18),  and  acknow- 
ledged (St.  John  vi.  14 ;  vii.  40),  the  eternal 
High  Priest  (Ps.  ex.  4 ;  Heb.  viii.  1 ;  x.  12, 
14),  and  universal  King  (Gen.  xlix.  10; 
Num.  xxiv.  17 ;  Ps.  ii.  6 ;  Dan.  vii.  14 ; 
Zech.  xiv.  9 ;  St.  Matt.  xxv.  34 ;  Rev.  xi.  15). 
And  this  Spirit  He  received  as  the  head 
(Heb.  i.  9),  and  conveys  to  the  members  of 
His  body  (2  Cor.  i.  21 ;  1  St.  John  ii.  20). 

MESSIANIC.  A  term  invented  by 
modern  critics,  to  signify  those  Psalms  or 
other  portions  of  Scripture  which  specially 
relate  to  or  personify  the  Messiah. 

METHODISTS,  POPISH.  Polemical 
doctors,  who  arose  in  Prance  about  the 
middle  of  the  seventeenth  century,  in  oppo- 
sition to  the  Huguenots,  or  French  Protes- 
tants. 

METHODISTS,  Origin  of  word.  The 
Greek  word  Me'^oSiKoi  was  applied  to  any 
one  who  practised  any  profession,  but  was 
principally  appKed  to  the  profession  of 
medicine,  and  to  the  doctor  who  treated 
his  patients  on  scientific  principles.  It  first 
came  into  use  in  modern  times  in  France  at 
the  beginning  of  the  17th  century,  when 
it  was  used  to  designate  a  school  of  theo- 
logians, the  most  illustrious  of  whom  was 

2  I  2 


iSi 


JIETHODISTS 


Bossuet.  Tlie  New  Methodists,  whose 
principal  doctrine  was  the  "  great  point  of 
justification,"  were  a  prominent  sect  some 
ten  years  before  John  Wesley's  birth.  The 
name  of  Methodists  was  given  to  Wesley 
and  the  society  which  early  looked  upon 
him  and  his  brother  as  their  leaders,  first 
of  all  in  derision  by  the  undergiaduates  of 
his  day,  but  became  ultimately  the  popular 
name  of  his  followers;  and  in  the  year 
1746,  was  fully  accepted  by  him  and  his 
society. 

John  Wesley. — This  remarkable  man, 
the  son  of  the  Eev.  Samuel  Wesley,  Rector 
of  Epworth  in  Lincolnshire,  was  born  in 
1703,  and  died  in  1791.  He  was  educated 
at  the  Charterhouse  and  at  Christ  Chui  ch. 
We  find  nothing  worthy  of  record  with 
regard  to  his  undergraduate  life  at  Oxford, 
[n  1725  he  took  deacon's  orders,  and  in  the 
foUowuig  year  he  obtained  a  fellowship  at 
Lincoln  College.  He  now  appears  to  have 
been  much  influenced  by  reading  Law's 
"  Serious  Call,"  and  "  Christian  Perfection." 
He  left  Oxford  and  took  a  curacy  in  Lincoln- 
shire. Thence  he  returned  to  Oxford  and 
joined  what  was  called  the  "  Godly  Club," 
a  society  of  young  men  who  agreed  together 
to  receive  the  Holy  Communion  once  a 
week,  and  fast  on  two  days  out  of  seven, 
and  who  occupied  themselves  in  visiting  the 
jirisons  and  the  sick.  In  the  year  1735 
Wesley  was  sent  out  as  a  minister  to 
Georgia  by  the  S.  P.  G. ;  but  liis  work  was 
unsuccessful,  and  after  three  years'  sojourn 
in  that  colony  he  returned  to  Oxford.  On 
nis  voyage  out  he  had  been  in  company 
\vith  some  German  Moravians,  by  whose 
example  and  conduct  he  had  been  much 
influenced.  On  his  return  to  London  he 
joined  their  Society,  and  soon  afterwards 
■paid  a  visit  to  their  headquarters  at 
Hermhut,  in  Germany.  The  influence  of 
the  young  Moravian  emigrant,  Peter  Bohler, 
was  at  this  time  of  service  to  John  and 
Charles  Wesley  in  their  spiritual  develop- 
ment ;  but  this  converse  with  the  Mora- 
vians also  greatly  tended  to  lessen  the  hold 
of  the  Church  system  upon  John  Wesley, 
and  paved  the  way  to  his  establishment  of  a 
community  to  .some  extent  independent  of 
it.  The  year  1739  found  Wesley  preaching 
at  Clifton,  whence  he  issued  his  famous 
manifesto.  "  1  look  upon  all  the  world 
as  my  parish,  thus  far  I  mean  that  in 
whatever  part  of  it  I  am  I  judge  it  meet 
right  and  my  bounden  duty  to  declare  unto 
all  that  are  willing  the  glad  tidings  of  salva- 
tion." This  declaration  was  followed  in  the 
same  year  by  the  building  of  a  Meeting 
House  at  Bristol  without  the  bishop's 
consent  or  that  of  the  clergyman  of  the 
.parish,  and  by  the  fitting  up  of  a  large  shed 
in  Windmill  Street,  Finsbury   Square,  for 


METHODISTS 

the  same  purpose.  This  was  the  first  direct 
step  towards  a  separation  from  the  Church, 
and  shows  the  different  ways  in  which 
Wesley  acted,  and  allowed  those  subject  to 
his  authority  to  act.  He  exacted  the 
strictest  obedience  from  his  own  subordinates, 
but  seems  only  himself  to  have  obeyed  the 
bishops  as  far  as  suited  liis  purposes. 
"  How  far,"  he  asks  in  1744, "  is  it  our  duty 
to  obey  the  bishops? "  His  reply  is,  " in  all 
things  indifferent,  and  on  this  ground  we 
should  obey  the  canons  as  far  as  we  can 
with  a  safe  conscience."  Again,  when  asked 
later  on,  on  what  authority  he  preached 
and  held  his  meetings,  he  replied,  "  by  the 
authority  of  Jesus  Christ  conveyed  to  me 
by  the  now  Archbishop  of  Canterbury 
when  he  laid  hands  upon  me  and  said, 
'  Take  thou  authority  to  preach  the  Word 
of  God. ' "  But  Wesley  omitted  the  rest  of 
the  sentence  .  .  .  .  "  where  thou  shalt  be 
lawfully  appointed  thereunto,"  another 
instance  of  the  way  in  which  he  disregarded 
authority  when  it  clashed  with  his  inchna- 
tions.  A  time  of  persecution  now  set  in 
for  awhile  which  found  vent  in  constant 
annoyances,  and  even  serious  hostility. 
Seven  of  the  lay  preachers  were  impressed 
by  the  press-gangs  of  the  jjeriod,  and  sent 
away  to  foreign  service ;  and  in  1768,  six 
students  were  expelled  from  St.  Edmund's 
Hall  for  the  only  reason  that  they  sympa- 
thised with  Wesley.  His  followers,  more- 
over, were  in  some  instances  driven  away 
from  the  parish  churches,  as  at  Epworth 
and  Scarborough,  by  unkind  treatment  and 
open  insult.  By  the  year  1744,  Methodism 
had  become  a  fact  in  English  bistory,  and 
the  first  conference  of  clergy  was  held  in 
Ixjudon.  This  conference  was  attended 
by  John  and  Charles  Wesley  and  four 
clerical  friends,  and  the  total  number  of 
members  in  the  London  Societies  was  esti- 
mated at  two  thousand.  Next  followed  the 
new  development  of  the  system  to  which  it 
owes  an  especial  character — the  appointment 
of  lay  preachers.  A  young  layman  named 
Maxfield  first  took  upon  himself  to  preach, 
unauthorised  by  Wesley,  in  the  chapel  at 
Moorfields.  Wesley,  after  much  consider- 
ation, permitted  the  innovation ;  and  before 
his  death  this  order  numbered  no  less  than 
five  hundred  members.  The  Methodists 
were  withdrawn  from  the  Church  more 
rapidly  by  this  innovation  than  by  anything 
else ;  for  by  seeing  laymen  perpetually  in 
their  pulpits,  they  soon  became  accustomed 
to  the  absence  of  ordained  clergy.  And 
when  the  few  clergy  who  assisted  the 
Wesleys  at  first,  died  or  ceased  to  work, 
the  teaching  went  on  under  the  lay 
preachers.  We  may  consider  that  this 
peculiarity  of  Methodism  has  given  it  its 
permanence.     But    although   Wesley    per- 


METHODISTS 

mitted  this  sclieme,  there  is  abundant 
evidence  that  it  was  an  innovation  ■whicli 
was  thrust  upon  him,  and  of  which  he 
never  heartily  approved.  The  lay  preacher 
entered  the  ranks  about  the  age  of  twenty, 
after  a  careful  examination  of  his  spiritual 
state  and  mental  fitness.  Wesley  gave  the 
lay  preachers  such  instniction  as  he  could 
on  the  rare  opportunities  on  which  he  met 
them,  and  although  self-taught,  many  of 
these  preachers  became  fair  teachers.  Their 
work  was  very  hard  at  first,  and  they  had 
long  distances  to  travel  in  all  weathers. 
They  were  expected  also  to  be  in  the 
Meeting  House  at  five  a.m.  Their  pay  was 
scarcely  sufiicient  to  supply  their  wants, 
and  they  were  not  allowed  to  supple- 
ment it,  except  by  the  sale  of  books 
and  tracts.  It  is  recorded  of  one  John 
Jane,  who  died  of  a  fever  brought  on  by 
over-walking,  and  died  "  without  a  struggle 
and  with  a  smile  upon  his  face,"  that 
after  the  funeral  expenses  had  been  paid,  a 
balance  of  Is.  id.  remained  for  his  represen- 
tatives, and  Wesley  is  reported  to  have 
said  on  hearing  of  this,  that  it  was  enough 
for  any  unmarried  preacher  of  the  Gospel 
to  have.  But  as  the  wealth  of  the  Metho- 
dists increased,  so  also  did  the  comfort  and 
the  salaries  of  the  preachers,  and  their  sons 
were  educated  free  of  expense  at  Kingswood 
School.  Much  of  Wesley's  time  was  spent 
in  travelling  in  Ireland,  Wales,  and  Scot- 
land. In  Ireland  he  met  with  success  from 
the  first,  and  but  little  persecution  except 
on  one  occasion  at  Cork,  where  in,  1749, 
the  famous  presentment  hj  the  grand  jury 
was  returned,  finding  that  Charles  Wesley 
and  his  friends  "  were  persons  of  ill  repute 
and  vagabonds.''  A  large  building  called 
the  New  Chapel  was  built  near  the  site  of 
the  old  cannon  foundry  which  had  been 
fitted  up  as  a  chapel  by  Wesley  in  Moor- 
fields,  nearly  forty  years  before,  in  1777,  and 
in  a  house  attached  to  it  Wesley  lived  when 
in  the  metropolis,  until  his  death  in  1791. 
In  1784  Wesley  was  hurried  into  one  of  the 
most,  perhaps  the  most,  indefensible  act  of 
his  life.  In  1760  a  few  Methodists  had 
landed  in  America,  and  help  had  been  sent 
to  them  in  1768,  but  the  mission  was  broken 
up  by  the  American  war.  When  the  war 
came  to  an  end,  the  idea  was  ever  present 
to  Wesley's  mind  how  to  make  provision 
for  supplying  thereK;iious  necessities  of  that 
great  country.  The  English  bishops  were 
applied  to,  but  there  were  leaal  and  political 
difficulties  in  their  way,  and  no  English 
bishop  could  be  induced  to  ordain  for 
America.  "  We  are  in  great  need  of  help," 
wrote  Francis  Asbury.  And  one  morning 
in  Bristol,  Wesley  went  through  a  form 
of  consecration  and  ordination,  by  which 
Dr.  Coke  considered  himself  raised  to  the 


METHODISTS 


4?5 


status  of  a  bishop,  and  Whatcoat  and  Vasey 
to  the  position  of  priests.  The  former  was 
to  superintend  the  missions  in  America  and 
the  others  to  preach  and  administer  the  Sa- 
craments. Wesley,  in  his  letter  to  America, 
was  careful  to  omit  the  word  "  bishop," 
using  only  the  word  "  superintendent." 
And  he  was  deeply  grieved  when  he  heard 
that  Coke  and  Asbury,  the  latter  of  whom 
had  received  no  kind  of  ordination  at  thin 
period,  but  whom  Coke  had  taken  upon 
himself  "  to  set  apart,"  had  assumed  the 
title  of  bishops.  This  unwise  step  on 
Wesley's  part  was  the  cause  of  much  sorrow 
to  many  of  his  friends.  A.  Knox  wrote  that 
Wesley  was  "  the  dupe  of  his  own  weakness 
and  other  men's  arts,"  and  C.  Wesley  from 
that  time  ceased  to  take  any  part  in  the 
affairs  of  the  Society. 

During  the  later  years  of  his  life  Wesley's 
following  increased  very  rapidly.  In  1780 
there  were  in  England  only  52,000  enrolled 
Methodists.  In  1790  there  were  194,000, 
and  during  the  same  period  the  number  of 
lay  preachers  doubled.  It  is  clear  that 
Wesley  never  intended  to  separate  from 
the  Church.  In  1751,  "  railing  against  the 
Church,"  as  a  very  grave  offence,  was 
brought  home  to  two  preachers,  and  Wesley 
expres'sed  his  determination  of  putting 
down  a  sin  which  he  describes  "as  the 
spirit  of  Ham  if  not  of  Korah."  In  1763 
the  "  Larger  Minutes  "  are  full  of  warning 
against  a  growing  tendency  of  separation 
from  the  Church.  In  1766,  one  of  searching 
questions  for  probationers  was, "  Do  you  con- 
stantly attend  Church  and  the  Sacraments  ?" 
"I  advise  aU  our  friends  to  keep  to  the 
Church,"  he  wrote  in  1778.  In  1785  he 
declared  at  a  meeting  of  the  Society  at 
Bristol  that  "  he  had  no  more  thought  of 
separating  from  the  Church  than  he  had 
forty  years  before."  Just  before  his  death 
he  prayed  for  the  Church  and  the  king. 
But  scarcely  was  he  dead  ere  his  followers 
began  to  prepare  for  the  separation  he  had 
repeatedly  denounced.  It  was  proposed  to 
divide  the  kingdom  into  four  Methodist 
bishoprics,  and  these  words  were  added, 
"  We  must  have  ordination  among  us  at  all 
events."  In  1836  a  regular  system  of 
ordination  was  established,  and  a  conference 
commissioned  the  preachers  to  administer 
the  Sacraments. 
Chii-f  Divisions : — 
I.  Wesleyans  under  Wesley's  deed  of 

settlement. 
II.  Kilhamites     or      New     Connexion 

separated,  1797. 

III.  Primitive  Methodists,  1810. 

IV.  Bryanites,  or  Bible  Christians,  1815, 
V.  Wesleyan     Methodist     Association, 

1834. 
VI.  Wesleyan  Methodist  Reformers,  1849. 


486 


METHODISTS 


(The  two  last  have  lately  coalesced  under 
the  title  of  The  United  Methodist  Free 
Church.) 

VII.  Free  Methodists,  1871. 
VIII.  The  Calvinistic  Methodists  form  two 
or  three  more  sects,  but  they  are 
for    the    most  part    followers  of 
Whitefield. 

Numbers. — The  Methodist  JRecorder  Sep- 
tember, 1885,  gives  the  following  as  the 
exact  number  of  some  of  these  sects  as 
reported  at  the  various  conferences  of  the 
year : — Wesleyans,  413,263,  increase  2,797  ; 
Primitives,  192,389,  increase  1,281 ;  Metho- 
dist Free  Churches,  76,385,  increase  544; 
New  Connexion,  29,327,  decrease  60 ;  Bible 
Christians,  26,359,  increase  314 ;  Wesleyans 
(Ireland),  24,971,  increase  105.  Total  num- 
ber, 762,594,  increase  5,041. 

Taking  the  growth  of  the  population  at 
so  low  a  rate  as  1  per  cent.,  it  would  appear 
from  this  that  Methodism  has  fallen  con- 
siderably into  arrear. 

Organisation. — The  classes  were  the 
very  first  of  the  arrangements  introduced 
by  Mr.  Wesley.  They  consist  in  general  of 
from  twelve  to  thirty  jjersons;  each  class 
having  its  appointed  leader,  an  experienced 
Christian  layman  nominated  by  the  super- 
intendent of  a  circuit,  and  appointed  by  a 
leaders'  meeting.  His  duty  is  to  meet  his 
class  once  a  week,  converse  with  each  class 
member,  hear  from  him  a  statement  of  his 
spiritual  condition,  and  give  appropriate 
counsel.  Every  member  of  a  class,  except 
in  cases  of  extreme  poverty,  is  expected  to 
contribute  towards  the  funds  of  the  Society. 
Out  of  the  proceeds  of  this  contribution, 
assisted  by  other  funds,  the  stipends  of  the 
ministers  are  paid.  The  system  of  class- 
meetings  is  justly  considered  the  very  life  of 
Methodism.  The  bands,  which  are,  or  more 
properly  were,  subdivisions  of  the  classes, 
consist  of  small  bodies  of  from  five  to  ten 
persons.  All  members  of  the  Society  are  not 
obliged  to  belong  to  one  of  these  bands ; 
but  it  was  Wesley's  intention  that  all 
should  so  associate  themselves  for  prayer 
and  mutual  help.  The  design  of  the  band, 
he  writes,  is  to  obey  that  command  of  God, 
"Confess  your  faults  one  to  another  and 
pray  one  for  another  that  ye  may  be 
healed."    The  chief  rules  are  : — 

(1)  To  meet  once  a  week. 

(2)  To  come  punctually. 

(3)  To  begin  with  singing  or  prayer. 

(4)  To  speak  each  of  us  in  order  freely 
and  plainly  the  true  state  of  our  souls  ■with. 
the  faults  we  have  committed  in  thought, 
word  and  deed,  and  the  temptations  we 
have  felt  since  our  last  meeting. 

(5)  To  desire  some  person  amongst  us  to 
speak  his  own  state  first  and  then  to  ask 
the  rest  in  order  as  many  and  as  searching 


METHODISTS 

questions  as  may  be  concerning  their  sins 
and  temptations.  Wesley  held  these  bands 
to  be  of  the  greatest  importance  for  the 
spiritual  welfare  of  his  followers.  The  nature 
of  the  confessions  made  at  them  required  that 
the  sexes  should  be  separated ;  and  the  bands 
were  arranged  of  persons  as  much  as  possible 
of  the  same  age,  so  that  their  confessions 
might  be  quite  unrestrained.  We  can 
hardly  wonder  that  these  meetings  fell  off 
very  considerably  after  Wesley's  influence 
was  removed,  and  that  they  are  now  almost, 
if  not  entirely,  extinct. 

Circuits. — The  classes  are  organised  into 
societies  which  include  the  chapels  in  some 
market  town  and  the  villages  for  some 
miles  around  it.  The  public  worship  of 
these  societies  is  conducted  in  each  circuit 
by  two  descriptions  of  preachers,  one 
clerical,  the  other  lay.  The  clerics  are 
separated  entirely  to  the  work  of  the 
ministry — are  members  of.  or  in  connexion 
with,  or  received  as  probationers  by,  the 
Conference^and  are  supported  by  funds 
raised  for  that  purpose  in  the  classes  and 
congregations.  Prom  one  to  four  of  these, 
called  "  itinerant  preachers,"  are  appointed 
annually  for  not  exceeding  three  years  in 
immediate  succession  to  the  same  circuit. 
Their  ministry  is  not  confined  to  any  par- 
ticular chapel  in  the  circuit,  but  they  act 
interchangeably  from  place  to  place,  seldom 
preaching  in  the  same  place  more  than  one 
Sunday  -without  a  change,  which  is  effected 
according  to  a  plan  generally  re-made  every 
quarter.  The  "  Minutes  of  Conference," 
1885,  give  the  number  of  ministerial  leaders 
as  1,214,  and  of  accredited  local  preachers  as 
14,721.  The  lay,  or  "local"  preachers,  as 
they  are  denominated,  follow  secular  callings, 
like  other  of  their  fellow  subjects,  and  preach 
on  the  Sabbaths  at  the  jjlaces  appointed  for 
them  in  the  above-mentioned  plan ;  as  great 
an  interval  being  observed  between  their 
appointments  to  the  same  place  as  can  be 
conveniently  arranged. 

The  public  services  of  Methodists  present 
a  combination  of  the  forms  of  the  Church 
of  England  with  the  usual  practice  of 
Dissenting  Churches.  In  the  larger  chapels, 
the  Church  Liturgy  is  used  with  certain 
alterations  and  omissions ;  and  the  sacrament 
is  administered  according  to  the  Church  of 
England  rubric,  but  more  frequently  after 
the  altered  and  shortened  form  drawn  up 
for  the  American  Methodists  in  1784.  The 
chief  alterations  in  this  form  are  the  substi- 
tution of  "  elder  "  for  "  priest " — the  omis- 
sion of  the  Nicene  Creed  and  of  the  second 
prayer  after  the  second  Lord's  Prayer — the 
permission  to  use  extempore  prayer  after  the 
"  Gloria  in  Excelsis  " — the  turning  of  the 
Absolution  and  the  Blessing  into  prayers. 
Independently  of    Sabbath   worship,    love 


METHODISTS 

feasts  are  occasionally  celebrated ;  and  a 
midnight  meeting,  on  the  last  day  of  each 
year,  is  in  many  places  held  as  a  solemn 
"  watch  night." 

At  inesent  there  are  about  59-i  circuits  in 
Great  Britain.  Besides  preaching  in  the 
various  chapels  in  their  respective  circuits, 
the  lay  itinerant  preachers  administer  the  sa- 
craments of  Baptism  and  the  Lord's  Supper. 
One  or  other  of  them,  according  to  an 
arrangement  amongst  themselves,  meets 
every  class  in  his  circuit  once  in  every 
quarter,  is  supposed  personally  to  converse 
with  every  member,  and  to  distribute  to  all 
such  as  have  throughout  the  past  three 
months  walked  orderly  a  ticket,  which  au- 
thenticates their  membership.  One  of  the 
ministers  in  every  circuit  is  called  the 
■"  superintendent,"  whose  duties,  in  addition 
to  his  ordinary  labours  as  a  travelling 
preacher,  are,  to  see  that  the  Methodist 
discipUne  is  properly  maintained, — to  admit 
candidates  into  membership  (subject  to  a 
veto  by  a  leaders'  meeting), — and  to  expel 
from  the  society  any  member  whom  a 
leaders'  meeting  shall  pronounce  guilty  of 
any  particular  oft'ence.  Appeal,  however, 
hes  from  his  decision  to  a  district  meeting, 
and  ultimately  to  the  Conference.  There  is 
also  a  "  circuit  steward,"  whose  duty  is  to 
receive  from  the  society  stewards  the  con- 
tributions of  class  members,  and  to  super- 
intend their  application  for  the  purposes  of 
the  circuit. 

Districts. — The  circuits  are  again  organ- 
ised into  districts  of  which  there  are  thirty- 
three  in  England  and  Wales,  each  containing 
some  eighteen  circuits.  They  were  arranged 
by  the  Conference  after  Wesley's  death, 
and  are  used  principally  for  gathering 
ministers  together.  Each  district  has  its 
chairman  and  secretary,  and  acts  as  a  kind 
of  local  committee  of  the  general  Conference. 
It  has  power  to  suspend  preachers,  authorise 
the  building  of  chapels,  and  deal  with 
questions  of  finance. 

The  Conference,  the  highest  Wesleyan 
court,  as  settled  by  Wesley  consisted  ex- 
clusively of  ministers,  but  of  late  years 
representative  laymen  have  been  elected  to 
attend  the  Conference.  It  derives  its  au- 
thority from  a  deed  of  declaration,  executed 
by  Mr.  Wesley  in  1784,  by  which  it  was 
provided  that,  after  the  decease  of  himself 
and  his  brother  Charles,  100  persons,  named 
in  the  deed,  "  being  preachers  and  ex- 
pounders of  God's  holy  word,  under  the  care 
and  in  connexion  with  the  said  John  Wes- 
ley," should  exercise  the  authority  which 
Wesley  himself  possessed,  to  appoint  preach- 
ers to  the  various  chapels.  Vacancies  in  the 
Legal  Hundred  were  to  be  filled  up  by  the 
remainder  at  an  annual  Conference.  In 
pursuance  of  tliis  deed,  a  Conference  of  100 


METHODISTS 


487 


ministers  meets  yearly  in  July,  with  the 
addition  of  the  representatives  selected  bj' 
the  district  meetings,  and  such  other  minis- 
ters as  are  appointed  or  permitted  to  attend 
by  the  district  committees  and  the  above- 
mentioned  lay  representatives.  The  custom 
is,  for  the  whole  body  to  share  in  the  pro- 
ceedings and  to  vote ;  but  all  the  decisions 
thus  arrived  at  must  be  sanctioned  by  the 
Legal  Hundred,  ere  they  can  have  binding 
force.  The  Conference  must  sit  for  at  least 
five  days,  but  not  beyond  three  weeks.  Its 
princii^al  transactions  are,  to  examine  the 
moral  and  ministerial  character  of  every 
preacher — to  receive  candidates  on  trial — to 
admit  ministers  into  the  Connexion — and  to 
appoint  ministers  to  particular  circuits  or 
stations.  Independently  of  its  functions 
under  this  deed  poll,  the  Conference  ex- 
ercises a  general  superintendence  over  the 
various  institutions  of  the  body ;  including 
the  appointment  of  various  committees,  as, 
(1)  llie  Committee  of  Privileges  for  guard- 
ing the  interests  of  the  Wesleyan  Con- 
nexion; (2)  The  Committee  for  the  man- 
agement of  Missions ;  (3)  The  Committee 
for  the  management  of  Schools  for  edu- 
cating the  children  of  Wesleyan  ministers  ; 
(4)  The  General  Book  Committee  (for 
superintending  the  pubhcation  and  sale  of 
Wesleyan  works) ;  (5)  The  Chapel  Building 
Committee  (without  whose  previous  consent 
in  writing  no  chapel,  whether  large  or 
small,  is  to  be  erected,  purchased,  or  en- 
larged) ;  (6)  The  Chapel  Belief  Committee  ; 
(7)  The  Contingent  Fund  Committee;  (8) 
The  Committee  of  the  Auxiliary  Fund  for 
worn-out  ministers  and  ministers'  widows ; 
and  the  committees  for  the  various  schools, 
theological  institutions,  &c. 

The  Conference  has  also  assumed  to  it- 
self the  power  of  making  new  laws  for  the 
government  of  the  Connexion ;  provided 
that,  if  any  cucuit  meeting  disapprove  such 
law,  it  is  not  to  be  enforced  in  that  circuit 
for  the  space  of  one  year.  Any  circuit  has 
the  power  of  memorializing  Conference  on 
behalf  of  any  change  considered  desirable, 
provided  the  June  quarterly  meeting  should 
so  determine. 

The  doctrines  held  by  the  Wesleyans  are 
substantially  accordant  with  the  Articles  of 
the  Estabhshed  Church,  interpreted  in  their 
Arminian  sense.  In  this  they  follow  Mr. 
Wesley  rather  than  Arminius ;  for  although 
the  writings  of  the  latter  are  received  with 
high  respect,  the  first  four  volumes  of 
Wesley's  Sermons,  and  his  Notes  on  the 
New  Testament  (which  they  hold  to  be 
"  neither  Calvinistic  on  the  one  hand  nor 
Pelagian  on  the  other  ")  are  referred  to  as 
the  standard  of  their  orthodoxy.  The  con 
tinned  influence  of  their  founder  is  mani- 
fested by  the  general  adherence  of  the  body 


488 


METHODISTS 


to  his  opinions  on  the  subject  of  attainment 
of  Christian  perfection  in  the  present  life — 
on  the  possibility  of  final  ruin  after  the 
reception  of  Divine  grace — and  on  the  ex- 
perience by  every  convert  of  a  clear  assur- 
ance of  his  acceptance  with  Grod  through 
faith  in  Jesus  Christ. 

Finances  of  the  Society. 
The  amounts  raised  by  this  Society  for 
their  various  societies  and  institutions  can 
only  be  approximately  arrived  at.  The 
Wesleyans  raised,  in  1884-5,  £146,308  for 
their  foreign  missions,  while  their  Home 
Missionary  income  for  the  same  period  was 
nearly  £38,000.  £21,944  were  expended 
on  the  education  of  ministers'  children  at 
the  connexional  schools;  £810,000  were 
contributed  in  Great  Britain  for  clxajel 
building;  and  £12,250  for  the  training  of 
candidates  for  the  ministrj-. 

The  "  Minutes  of  Conference "  for  1885 
contain  the  following  statistics  of  the  schools 
of  this  persuasion  : — 

DAT  Schools  («44). 
Total  number  of  scholars  .     .     .     178,056 
Average  attencance      ....     132,855 

School  pence  .......  £100,698 

Government  grant 110,334 

Subscription^,  &c 23,545 

Total  Income      .     .  .    234,578 

Spent  on  teaching  staff      .     .     .     185,974 
Other  expenditure SQ,718 

£236,692 


Sunday  Snnoots. 
Number  of  schools   .     .     . 


£74,259 


125,502 
102,388 
862,279 
204,912 
188,112 
105,123 


Total  annual  cost     .... 

Officers  and  teachers     .     . 

„       in  society  or  on  irial 
Number  of  scholars.     .     .     . 

,,        under  7  years  of  age  . 

„        above  15        „ 

„       in  society  or  on  trial  . 

^'raining  Colleges,  1885  : — 

(1)  Westminster  male  btudents  in  train- 

ing,  116. 

(2)  Soutlilands  female  students  in  train- 

ing, 109. 

Minutes  of  Conference,  1885. 

GENERAL  VIEW. 


I. 
li. 


III. 


In  Great  Britain  . 

In    Ireland     and) 

Iiish  Missions  .J 

In    Foreign    Mis-1 

sions.     .     .     .J 

French  Conference 

V.  South  African  Con-l 

ference   .     .     J 

TI.  West  Indian  Con- 1 

ferences  .     .     .] 

Totals.     .     . 


IV 


413,143 

24,971 

29,133 

1,703 

22,816 

43,317 


535,103 


30,861 
862 

4,213 

94 

8,836 

1,807 


46,673  2,162 


1,589 
173 

203 
28 
102 


E-= 


Minutes  of  Conference,  1885. 


METHODISTS 

THE  METHODIST  NEW  CONNEXION. 

For  some  time  after  Mr.  Wesley's  deatb 
in  1791,  considerable  agitation  was  raised 
throughout  the  numerous  societies  which  had 
rapidly  sprung  up  in  every  part  of  England. 
The  more  immediate  subjects  of  dispute  had 
reference  to  (1)  "  the  right  of  the  people 
to  hold  their  public  religious  worship  at  such 
hours  as  were  most  convenient,  without  being 
restricted  to  hours  intervening  between  ser- 
vices in  the  Established  Church ;"  and  (2). 
"  the  right  of  the  people  to  receive  the  ordi- 
nances of  Baptism  and  the  Lord's  supper  from 
the  hands  of  their  own  ministers,  and  in  their 
own  places  of  worship ;"  but  the  principal 
and  fundamental  question  in  dispute  con- 
cerned the  right  of  the  laity  to  participate  in 
the  spiritual  and  secular  government  of  the 
body.  Wesley  himself  had,  in  his  life-time, 
always  exercised  an  absolute  authority ;. 
and  after  his  decease  the  travelling  preach- 
ers claimed  the  same  extent  of  power.  A 
vigorous  opposition  was,  however,  soon 
originated,  which  continued  during  several 
years ;  the  Conference  attempting  various 
unsuccessful  measures  for  restoring  har- 
mony. A  "  Plan  of  Pacification "  was 
adopted  by  the  Conference  in  1795,  and 
was  received  with  general  satisfaction  so- 
far  as  the  ordinances  were  concerned ;  but 
the  question  of  lay  influence  remained  un- 
touched till  1797,  when  the  Conference 
conceded  that  the  leaders'  meetings  should 
have  the  right  to  exercise  an  absolute  veto 
upon  the  admission  of  new  members  to  the 
Society,  and  that  no  member  should  be  ex- 
pelled for  immorality,  "until  such  immo- 
1  ality  had  been  proved  at  a  leaders'  meeting." 

Foremost  amongst  many  who  remained 
unsatisfied  by  these  concessions  was  Alex- 
ander KiUiam,  who,  singularly  enough,  was- 
born  at  Epworth  in  Lincolnshire,  the  birth- 
place of  the  Wesleys.  Mr.  Kilham,  first 
acquiring  prominence  as  an  assertor  of  the 
right  of  Methodists  to  meet  for  worship  in 
church  hours,  and  to  receive  the  sacraments 
from  their  own  ministers,  was  gradually  led 
to  take  an  active  part  in  advocacy  of  the 
principle  of  lay  participation  m  the  govern- 
ment of  the  Connexion. 

In  doctrines,  and  in  all  the  essential  and 
distinctive  features  of  Wesleyan  Methodism, 
there  is  no  divergence  between  the  New- 
Connexion  and  the  parent  body :  the  Ar- 
minian  tenets  are  as  firmly  held;  and  the 
outline  of  -  ecclesiastical  machinery — com- 
prising classes,  circuits,  districts,  and  the 
Conference — is  in  both  the  same.  The 
grand  distinction  rests  u]ix)n  the  different 
degrees  of  power  allowed  in  each  com- 
munion to  the  laity.  It  has  been  sliown 
that,  in  the  "  Origmal  Connexion,"  all  au- 
thority is  virtually  vested  in  the  preachers  : 


METHODISTS 

tliey  alone  compose  the  Conference — their 
influence  is  paramount  in  the  inferior  courts 
— and  even  wlien,  as  in  financial  matters, 
laymen  aie  appointed  to  committees,  such 
appointments  are  entirely  in  the  hands  of 
Conference.  The  "New  Connexion,"  on 
the  contrary,  admits,  in  all  its  courts,  the 
principle  of  lay  participation  in  Church 
government :  candidates  for  membership 
must  be  admitted  by  the  voice  of  the  exist- 
ing membera,  not  by  the  minister  alone ; 
oflending  members  cannot  be  expelled  but 
with  the  concurrence  of  a  leaders'  meeting ; 
officers  of  the  body,  whether  leaders,  min- 
isters, or  stewards,  are  elected  by  the  Church 
and  ministers  conjointly ;  and  in  district 
meetings  and  the  annual  Conference  lay 
delegates  (as  many  in  number  as  the  min- 
isters) are  present,  freely  chosen  by  the 
members  of  the  Churches. 

The  progress  of  (he  New  Connexion  since 
its  origin  has  been  as  follows,  in  the  aggre- 
gate, comprising  England,  Ireland,  and  the 
Colonies : 

Year.  Members. 

1797 5,000 

1803 5,280 

1813        8,067 

1823 10,794 

1833 14,784 

1840 21,836 

1846 20,002 

1853 21,384 

1870 22,633 

1885 29,327 

This  Society,  in  the  year  1884-5,  raised 
for  chapel  fund  £976 ;  ior  missions  £5,831 ; 
for  home  missions  £951.  It  numbers  a  con- 
siderable following  out  of  England. 

PRIMITIVE  METHODISTS. 

About  the  commencement  of  the  present 
century  certain  among  the  Wesleyans  (and 
conspicuously  Hugh  Bourne  and  WiUiam 
Clowes)  began  to  put  in  practice  a  revival 
of  those  modes  of  operation  which  had  by 
that  time  been  abandoned  by  the  then  con- 
solidated body.  The  Conference  of  1807 
affirmed  a  resolution  adverse  to  such  unpre- 
scribed  expedients ;  and  the  consequence  of 
this  disapprobation  was  the  birth  of  the 
Primitive  Methodist  Connexion.  In  1808 
Bourne  was  expelled  from  the  Methodist 
Body  by  the  Burslem  Quarterly  Meeting,  and 
in  1810  this  expulsion  was  followed  by  that 
of  Clowes.  These  two  local  preachers  at 
once  began  to  form  a  new  sect,  and  were 
joined  by  sixteen  congregations  and  twenty- 
eight  jireachers,  in  Lancashire  and  York- 
shke.  The  organisation,  the  nucleus  of 
which  was  thus  formed,  has  become  the 
most  dangerous  rival  of  the  parent  Society, 
and  numbers  more  members  than  all  its  other 


METHODISTS  489 

offshoots  put  together.  The  first  class  was 
fonned  in  1810  at  Slandley  in  Staffordshire. 
The  Society  then  numbered  ten  members. 
Since  that  date  it  has  rapidly  increased,  as. 
the  following  table  will  show  : — 

Year.  Meraberg. 

1810 10 

18U 200 

1820 7,842 

1830 35,733 

1840 73,990 

1850 104,762 

1853 108,926 

1870 150,169 

1885 192,389 

In  1870  their  chapels  were  reckoned  as 
6,397,  their  travelling  preachers  as  961,  and 
their  local  preachers  as  14,332.  At  this- 
period  they  counted  only  41  day  schools, 
but  271,802  Sunday  scholars  with  47,379 
teachers.  But  these  numbers  have  advanced 
since  that  date  in  proportion  to  the  increase 
in  the  number  of  members.  The  "  Camp 
Meetings,"  with  which  the  names  of  the 
founders  of  this  Connexion,  and  their 
American  assistant,  Lawrence  Dow,  were- 
so  inseparably  connected,  had  even  in  1853 
become  infrequent,  as  the  people  were  con- 
sidered to  be  accessible  to  other  agencies. 

BIBLE  CHHISTIANS. 

The  "  Bible  Christians"  (sometimes  called 
Bryanites)  are  included  here  among  the 
Methodist  communities,  more  from  a  refer- 
ence to  their  sentiments  and  polity  than  to 
their  origin.  The  body,  indeed,  was  not 
the  result  of  a  secession  from  the  Methodist 
Connexion,  but  was  rather  the  origination 
of  a  new  community,  which,  as  it  grew,, 
adopted  the  essential  principles  of  Meth- 
odism. 

The  foimder  of  the  body  was  Mr.  Wilham 
0' Bryan,  a  Wesley  an  local  preacher  in 
Cornwall,  who,  in  1815,  separated  from  the- 
Wesleyans,  and  be<;an  himself  to  form 
societies  upon  the  Methodist  plan.  In  a 
very  few  years  considerable  advance  was 
made,  and  throughout  Devonshire  and 
Cornwall  many  societies  were  established ; 
so  that  in  1819  there  were  nearly  thirty 
itinerant  preachers.  In  that  year  the  first 
Conference  was  held,  when  the  Connexion, 
was  divided  into  twelve  circuits.  Mr. 
O'Bryan  withdrew  from  the  body  in  1829. 
In  doctrinal  profession  there  is  no  distinction 
between  "  Bible  Christians,"  and  the  various 
bodies  of  Arminian  Methodists.  The  forms 
of  public  -worship  too  are  of  the  same  simple, 
character ;  but  in  the  administration  of  the 
Lords  Supper  "  it  is  usual  to  receive  the 
elements  in  a  sitting  posture,  as  it  is  believed 
that  that  practice  is  more  conformable  to- 


490 


METHODISTS 


the  posture  of  body  in  wliich  it  was  at  first 
received  by  Christ's  Apostles  tlian  kneeling ; 
but  persons  are  at  liberty  to  kneel,  if  it  be 
more  suitable  to  their  views  and  feelings  to 
■do  so."  They  allow  women  to  preach,  and 
their  preachers  form  the  smaller  portion  of 
their  governing  body.  The  Bryanites  are 
-specially  a  "West  Country  sect,  their  principal 
following  being  in  Cornwall,  Devonshire, 
Somersetshire,  and  Wales.  They  have  also 
small  offshoots  in  Canada  and  Australia. 
This  Society  numbered  13,862  members  in 
1852,  18,466  in  1870,  and  their  Minutes  of 
•Conference  for  1885  return  their  numbers 
AH  26,359. 

UNITED  METHODIST  FEEE  CHUECH. 

This  body  is  composed  of  the  \mion  of 
the  Wesleyan  Methodist  Reformers,  the 
Protestant  Methodist  Society  formed  Id  1828, 
.and  the  Wesleyan  Methodist  Association. 

WESLEYAN  METHODIST  EEFOEMEBS. 

In  1849,  another  of  the  constantly  re- 
curring agitations  with  respect  to  ministerial 
authority  in  matters  of  Church  discipline 
.arose,  and  still  continues.  Some  parties 
having  circulated  through  the  Connexion 
-certain  anonymous  pamphlets  called  "  Fly 
Sheets,"  in  which  some  points  of  Methodist 
procedure  were  attacked  in  a  manner  offen- 
.sive  to  the  Conference,  that  body,  -with  a 
view  to  ascertain  the  secret  authors  (sus- 
jjected  to  be  ministers),  adopted  the  ex- 
jjedient  of  tendering  to  every  minister  in 
the  Connexion  a  "  Declaration,"  reprobating 
the  obnoxious  circulars,  and  repudiating  all 
■connexion  with  the  authorship.  Several 
ministers  refused  submission  to  tbis  test,  as 
being  an  unfair  attempt  to  make  the  offend- 
ing parties  criminate  themselves,  and  par- 
taking of  the  nature  of  an  Inquisition.  The 
•Conference,  however,  held  that  such  a 
method  of  examination  was  both  Scripturally 
proper,  and  accordant  with  the  usages  of 
Methodism ;  and  the  ministers  persisting  in 
their  opposition  were  expelled.  This  strin- 
gent measure  caused  a  great  sensation 
through  the  various  societies,  and  meetings 
were  convened  to  sympathise  with  the 
excluded  ministers.  The  Conference,  how- 
ever, steadily  pursued  its  policy — con- 
■sidered  all  such  meetings  violations  of 
Wesleyan  order — and,  acting  through  the 
superintendent  ministers  in  all  the  circuits, 
punished  by  expulsion  every  member  who 
attended  them.  In  consequence  of  this 
proceeding,  the  important  question  was 
again,  and  with  increased  anxiety,  debated, 
— whether  the  admission  and  excision  of 
Church  members  is  exclusively  the  duty 
of  the  minister,  or  whether,  in  the  exercise 
•of  such  momentous  discipline,   the   other 


METHODISTS 

members  of  the  Church  have  not  a  right  to 
share. 

This  great  body  of  excommunicated  Meth- 
odists soon  became  settled  into  a  distinct  sect, 
and  reported  itself  as  possessing  339  chapels 
with  an  attendance  of  some  35,000  persons 
at  their  services.  In  the  year  1857  the 
Methodist  Association  and  Reformers  united 
together  under  the  title  of  "  The  United 
Methodist  Free  Churches."  This  important 
body  numbered,  in  1870, 62,898  members  of 
classes  with  5786  on  trial,  and  5000  else- 
where than  in  England.  Its  Minutes  of 
Conference  for  1885  return  76,385  as  the 
total  number  of  members  at  the  present 
time. 

CALVINISTIC  METHODISTS. 

George  Whitefield,  born  in  1714,  the  son 
of  an  innkeeper  at  Gloucester,  was  admitted 
as  a  servitor  at  Pembroke  College,  Oxford, 
in  1732.  Being  then  the  subject  of  re- 
ligious impressions,  to  which  the  evil  cha- 
racter of  his  early  youth  lent  force  and 
poignancy,  he  naturally  was  attracted  to 
those  meetings  for  religious  exercises  which 
the  brothers  Wesley  had  a  year  or  two  be- 
fore originated.  After  a  long  period  of 
mental  anguish,  and  the  practice,  for  some 
time,  of  physical  austerities,  he  ultimately 
found  relief  and  comfort ;  and,  resolving 
to  devote  himself  to  the  labours  of  the 
ministry,  was  admitted  into  holy  orders  by 
the  bishop  of  Gloucester.  Preaching  in 
various  churches  previous  to  his  embark- 
ation for  Georgia,  whither  he  had  deter- 
mined to  follow  Mr.  Wesley,  his  uncommon 
force  of  oratory  was  at  once  discerned,  and 
scenes  of  extraordinary  popular  commotion 
were  displayed  wherever  he  appeared.  In 
1737  he  left  for  Georgia,  just  as  Wesley 
had  returned.  He  ministered  with  much 
success  among  the  settlers  for  three  months, 
and  then  came  back  to  England,  for  the 
purpose  of  procuring  aid  towards  the 
foundation  ot  an  orphan  house  for  the 
colony.  The  same  astonishing  sensation 
was  created  by  his  preaching  as  before ;  the 
ch\irches  overflowed  with  eager  auditors, 
and  crowds  would  sometimes  stand  outside. 
Perceiving  that  no  edifice  was  large  enough 
to  hold  the  numbers  who  desired  and 
pressed  to  hear  him,  he  began  to  entertain 
the  thought  of  preaching  in  the  open  air ; 
and  when,  on  visiting  Bristol  shortly  after, 
all  the  pulpits  were  denied  to  him,  he 
carried  his  idea  into  practice,  and  com- 
menced his  great  experiment  by  preaching 
to  the  colUers  at  Kingswood.  His  first 
audience  numbered  about  200 ;  the  second, 
2000;  the  third,  4000;  and  so  from  ten 
to  fourteen  and  to  twenty  thousand.  Such 
success  encouraged  similar  attempts  in 
London ;  and  accordingly,  when  the  church- 


METHODISTS 

wardens  of  Islington  forbade  his  entrance 
into  the  pulpit,  which  the  vicar  had  offered 
him,  he  preached  in  the  churchyard;  and, 
deriving  more  and  more  encouragement 
from  his  success,  he  made  Moorfields  and 
Kennington  Common  the  scenes  of  his  im- 
IJassioned  eloquence,  and  there  controlled, 
persuaded,  and  sui)dued  assemblages  of 
thirty  and  forty  thousand  of  the  rudest 
auditors.  He  again  set  out  for  Georgia, 
but  in  1740,  being  suspended  by  the  Epi- 
scopal Commissary  in  Georgia  for  ecclesias- 
tical irregularities,  he  returned  to  England 
in  March,  1741.  The  rest  of  bis  life  was 
spent  in  a  restless  and  roving  manner,  partly 
in  England,  and  partly  in  America.  He 
made  thirteen  voyages  across  the  Atlantic, 
and  seldom  remained  but  a  few  days  to- 
gether in  any  place  which  he  visited. 
Whilst  in  America  in  1740,  he  received 
information  respecting  Wesley's  preaching 
of  Arminian  doctrines  from  John  Cennick, 
one  of  the  Methodist  lay-preachers,  who 
entreated  him  to  return  home  and  oppose 
the  "  heresy  "  of  their  leader.  Up  to  this 
period,  Wesley  and  Whitefield  had  harmo- 
niously laboured  in  conjunction;  but  the 
<liflference  of  sentiment  which  now  arose 
between  them  on  the  doctrine  of  election 
proving,  after  some  discussion,  to  be  quite 
irreconcilable,  they  thenceforth  each  pur- 
sued a  different  patli,  Mr.  Wesley  stead- 
ily and  skilfully  constructing  the  elaborate 
machinery  of  Wesleyan  Methodism,  and 
AVhitefield  following  his  x^lan  of  field  itiner- 
ancy with  a  constant  and  amazing  popular- 
ity, but  making  no  endeavour  to  originate  a 
sect.  He  died  in  New  England  in  1769,  at 
the  age  of  55. 

His  followers,  however,  and  those  of 
other  eminent  evangelicals  who  sympathised 
with  his  proceedings,  gradually  settled  into 
separate  religious  iDodies,  principally  under 
two  distinctive  appellations ;  one,  the 
"  Countess  of  Huntingdon's  Connexion," 
and  the  other,  the  "  Welsh  Calvinistic 
Methodists."  These,  in  fact,  are  now  the 
only  sections  wMch  survive  as  individual 
communities ;  for  most  of  Whitefield's  con- 
gregations, not  adopting  any  connexional 
bond,  but  existing  as  independent  churches, 
gradually  became  absorbed  into  the  Con- 
gregational Body. 

WELSH  CALVINISTIC  METHODISTS. 

The  great  revival  of  religion  commenced 
in  England  by  Wesley  and  Whitefield  had 
been  preceded  by  a  similar  event  in  Wales. 
The  principal  agent  of  its  introduction  there 
was  Howel  Harris,  a  gentleman  of  Trevecca 
in  Brecknockshire,  who,  with  a  view  to 
holy  orders,  had  begun  to  study  at  Oxford, 
but,  offended  at  the  immorality  there  pre- 


METHODISTS 


491 


valent,  had  quitted  college,  and  returned  to 
Wales.  He  shortly  afterwards  began  a 
missionary  labour  in  that  country,  going 
from  house  to  house,  and  preaching  in  the 
open  air.  In  1739  he  had  established  about 
300  "secret  societies,"  similar  to  those 
which  Wesley  was,  about  the  same  time, 
though  without  communication,  forming  in 
England. 

Tho  growth  of  the  movement,  both  in 
North  and  South  Wales,  was  extremely- 
rapid  ;  but  the  process  of  formation  into  a 
separate  body  was  more  gradual  and  slow. 
At  first,  as  several  of  the  most  conspicuous 
labourers  were  clergymen  of  the  Established 
Church,  the  sacraments  were  administered 
exclusively  by  them;  but,  as  converts 
multiphed,  the  number  of  evangelical  clergy- 
men was  found  inadequate  to  the  occasion : 
and  many  members  were  obhged  to  seek 
communion  with  the  various  dissenting 
bodies ;  till,  at  last,  in  1811,  twelve  of  the 
Methodist  preachers  were  ordained  at  a  con- 
siderable Conference,  and  from  that  time  forth 
the  sacraments  were  regularly  administered 
by  them  in  their  o^vn  chapels,  and  the  body 
assumed  distinctly  the  appearance  of  a 
separate  Connexion. 

The  doctrines  of  the  Welsh  Calvinistic 
Methodists  may  he  inferred  from  the  appel- 
lation of  the  body,  and  be  said  to  be  sub- 
stantially accordant  with  the  Articles  of  the 
Established  Church,  interpreted  according 
to  their  Calvinistic  sense. 

In  1858  the  number  of  chapels  belonging 
to  this  body  was  reported  to  be  828  and  the 
number  of  its  members  to  be  about  58,577. 
In  1870  their  sect  numbered  about  60,000, 
and  they  possessed  some  200  ministers  and 
250  lay  preachers.  They  have  two  training 
colleges  for  their  ministers  at  Bala  and 
Trevecca. 

METHODISTS,  AMERICAN. 

In  the  year  1738  Whitefield  began  to 
preach  in  America,  and  in  this  country  he 
spent  more  then  one-third  of  his  Ufe.  But 
he  organised  no  separate  sect,  leaving  his 
converts  to  the  care  of  the  various  denomi- 
nations to  which  they  happened  to  belong. 
The  first  Methodist  congregation  was 
formed  by  some  emigrants  from  Ireland,  who 
in  1768  erected  the  first  Methodist  chapel 
in  America,  in  John  St.,  New  York.  Wesley 
sent  out  teachers  to  this  community,  but  they 
all  returned  home  on  the  outbreak  of  the 
war  of  Independence.  The  sect  nevertheless 
continued  to  prosper,  and  at  the  end  of  the 
war  in  1783,  they  numbered  14,000  mem- 
bers and  some  43  ministers.  In  1784,  the 
sect  so  formed  was  reconstituted  by  Wesley, 
who  sent  out  Dr.  Coke  and  Mr.  Asbury 
(who  had  been  a  missionary  in  America  ten 
years  before)  to  act  as  "  superintendents," 


492 


METEOPOLITAK 


but  really  with  the  authority  of  bishops.  He 
enjoined  upon  them  the  use  of  his  abridged 
Book  of  Common  Prayer  (which  however 
was  speedily  thrown  aside),  and  arranged  for 
them  twenty-five  articles  of  religion  as  their 
standard  of  doctrine.  This  body,  thus  re- 
organised, took  the  title  of  the  "  Methodist 
E  piscopal  Church"  and  has  e ver  si  n  ce  retained 
the  constitution  given  to  it  by  Wesley. 
Its  general  organisation  is  the  same  as  that 
of  the  English  Methodists,  but  its  ministers 
are  respectively  denominated  bishops,  eld- 
ers, and  deacons.  In  the  Norihern  States, 
in  1870,  this  body  of  Methodists  num- 
bered some  800,000  members,  and  11,000 
preachers,  and  in  the  Southern  States  before 
the  war  "  more  than  half  a  million  with 
about  6,000  preachers."  We  can  scarcely 
estimate  the  strength  of  this  body  in 
America  at  the  present  moment  at  less 
than  one  and  a  half  millions. 

METHODIST  KEFORMED  AMERICAN  CHURCH. 

This  sect  separated  in  1814  from  the  Me- 
thodist Episcopal  Church.  They  renounced 
the  Episcopal  system,  and  re-formed  them- 
selves as  closely  as  possible  after  the 
original  Methodist  plan.  In  1843  this 
body  was  strengthened  by  a  further  secession 
from  the  parent  sect,  but  their  numbers  are 
not  large. 

THE    AFRICAN   EPISCOPAL  METHOBISTS   AND 
THE  ZION  WESLEY  METHODISTS 

Are  oifshoots  of  black  seceders  from  the 
original  Methodist  Society  in  the  North. 
They  hold  the  same  doctrines  as  the  parent 
society,  but  have  separated  on  account  of  the 
contemptuous  treatment  they  received  at 
the  hands  of  their  white  brethren,  and  the 
Zion  Methodists  had  a  further  quarrel  with 
the  Conference  of  the  orginal  sect  with 
regard  to  their  chapels  and  salaries. 

THE  METHODIST  PROTESTANT  CHURCH. 

A  secession  of  3  820  now  includes  as 
well  certain  seceders  of  1830  who  styled 
themselves  the  "  Methodist  Society."  They 
both  seceded  on  small  questions  of  organ- 
isation. They  number  together  more  than 
100,000  members. 

Minutes  of  Conference ;   Wesley's  works  ; 
UrlMs   Life  of    Wesley ;  Diet,   of   Sects ; 
Hockin's  John  Wesley  and  Modern  Wesley- 
— __are»sm,  (fee.     [P.  H.] 

IVIETROPOLITAN.  The  presiding  bi- 
shop of  a  province,  so  called  because  in 
primitive  times  his  see  was  commonly  fixed 
in  the  civil  metropolis. 

In  the  earliest  period  bishops  were  all 
equal  to  and  independent  of  each  other, 
the  apostles  during  their  lifetime  exercising 
supervision  over  all  Churches.   Some  writers 


MICHAEL,  ST. 

(e.g.  Archbishop  Ussher,  "Original  of  Bi- 
shops and  Metropolitans")  have  thought 
that  the  apostles  themselves  established  an 
order  of  metropolitans  superior  to  the  or- 
dinary bishops,  but  there  does  not  seem  to 
be  sufficient  evidence  for  this  view.  It  is, 
however,  nearly  certain  that  the  metro- 
pohtical  office  arose  in  the  age  succeeding 
that  of  the  apostles.  Its  origin  was  doubt- 
less due  to  the  practice  of  holding  pro- 
vincial synods,  which  some  one  must  con- 
vene and  preside  over,  and  also  to  the 
necessity  of  having  some  person  by  whom^ 
vacant  sees  could  be  administered,  and  to 
whom  disputes  could  be  referred.  Ac- 
cordingly we  find  in  the  so-called  Apostolic 
Canons  a  direction  (Cora.  Apost.  xxxiii.)  that 
the  bishops  of  each  nation  (cKao-rou  t6mvs} 
should  lecognise  one  as  their  head.  It  was- 
natural  that  this  one  should  be  the  bishop 
of  the  civil  metropolis,  since  he  was  most 
accessible  to  all  people  in  the  province.  In 
a  contention  between  the  bishops  of  Aries 
and  Vienne  for  metropolitical  rights  the 
Council  of  Turin  (a.d.  397)  ordered  that 
"  the  one  who  could  prove  his  city  to  be 
the  metropolis  should  have  the  honour  of 
the  primacy  over  the  whole  province  "  (^Oonc. 
Taurin.  can.  ii.).  But  the  authority  of  me- 
tropohtans  existed  long  before  this.  It  pro- 
bably arose  during  the  second  century,  and 
is  referred  to  by  the  famous  Council  of 
Nicaja  (a.d.  325)  as  an  "  ancient  custom " 
{Cone.  Nic.  can.  vi.).  In  Africa  alone  the 
primacy  did  not  belong  to  the  bishop  of 
the  civil  metropolis,  but  to  the  senior  bishop 
of  the  province.  In  England  the  two> 
Metropolitan  Sees  are  Canterbury  and  York, 
the  former  as  having  been  the  first  founded 
after  the  landing  of  St.  Augustine,  and  the 
latter  partly  because  it  was  the  first  planted 
in  Northumhria,  and  partly  becnuse  it  had 
been  marked  out  for  the  northern  metro- 
polis in  the  original  scheme  of  Gregory  the 
Great  (See  Bede,  H.  E.  i.  29). 

The  chief  privileges  of  metropolitans  were, 
the  consecration  of  their  suffragan  bishops, 
the  decision  of  controversies,  and  hearing  of 
appeals,  the  summoning  of  provincial  synods, 
and  presiding  in  the  same,  the  visitation 
and  correction  of  offending  Churches,  and 
the  administration  of  vacant  sees.  In  the 
exercise  of  these  powers,  however,  the  metro- 
politan was  not  to  act  arbitrarily,  but  to 
consult  his  provincial  synod,  and  generally  to 
decide  "  according  to  the  majority  of  votes  " 
(See  Patriarch  and  Archbishop).     [H.] 

MICHAEL,  ST.,  AND  ALL  ANGELS  r 
a  festival  observed  on  September  29  ;  in  the 
Eastern  Church  on  November  8.  It  was 
also  sometimes  kept  on  May  8,  but  the 
present  day  is  that  given  in  the  Comes  of 
Jerome  and  the  Sacramentary  of  Gregory. 
St.  Michael  is  described  in  the  Old  Testa- 


MID-LENT  SUNDAY 

siient  as  the  guardian  angel  of  tlie  Jews; 
in  the  New  Testament  he  is  the  great 
archangel,  the  type  of  the  warrior  angel, 
fighting  for  God  and  His  Church,  against 
the  power  of  the  devil.  Beyond  this  there 
is  nothing  but  a  mass  of  legend,  and  con- 
jecture (L)an.  X.  13,  21 ;  xii.  1 ;  Jude  9 ; 
Rev.  xii.  7).     See  Angels. 

MID-LENT  SUNDAY :  the  fourth  Sun- 
day in  Lent.  It  was  anciently  known  as 
Dominica  Sefectionis,  or  Refreshment  Sun- 
•day,  probably  from  the  subject  of  the  Gospel 
— the  feeding  the  five  thousand  in  the  wil- 
derness. Others  attribute  the  name  to  the 
fact  that  on  this  Sunday  above  others  in 
Lent,  certain  festivities  have  sometimes 
been  allowed,  as  at  the  Mi-Careme  in 
France,  and  the  benediction  of  the  Golden 
Rose  by  the  Pojje  at  Rome.  It  was  an  old 
practice  in  England  to  feast  on  rich  cakes 
and  spiced  ale  on  this  day ;  and  it  was  also 
a  custom  to  visit  the  mother  church  of  the 
diocese,  and  to  make  offerings  at  the  high 
altar,  whence  it  was  called  "  Mothering  Sun- 
day." Presents  also  were  in  many  places 
made  by  children  to  their  parents,  which 
often  took  the  form  of  what  were  called 
"  Mothering  Cakes." — Brand's  Ant. :  Wheatly, 
222 ;  E.  Daniel,  P.  B.     [H.] 

MIDWIVES,  BAPTISM  BY.  Such  per- 
sons were  constantly  licensed  to  baptize 
down  to  recent  times  (Burn,  Ecc.  Law, 
art.  Midiuives). 

MILITANT  (From  Lat.  militans,  "  fight- 
ing ").  A  tenn  apphed  to  the  Church  on 
earth,  as  engaged  in  a  warfare  with  the  world, 
sin,  and  the  devil ;  in  distinction  from  the 
Church  triumphant  in  heaven.  It  is  used 
in  the  prefatory  sentence  of  the  prayer 
after  the  Offertory  in  our  Communion  Ser- 
vice, and  was  first  inserted  in  the  Second 
Book  of  King  Edward  VI. 

MILLENARIANS  and  MILLENNIUM 
(Mille — annus).  A  name  which  is  given 
to  those  who  believe  that  Christ  will  reign 
personally  for  a  thousand  years  upon  earth. 
They  were  also  called  ChUiasts,  from  the 
Greek  xi^""- 

L  The  doctrine  of  the  Millennium  is  said 
to  be  of  Jewish  origin  (but  see  Dr.  Walch, 
Hist,  der  Ketzereien,  ii.  p.  143),  and  passed 
from  Judaism  into  Christianity.  Papias, 
the  pupil  of  St.  John,  had  the  reputation  of 
being  the  author  of  Christian  Millenarianism 
(Euseb.  iii.  39) ;  and  the  prophecies  of  the 
Old  Testament,  as  Is.xxvi.  19,Ezek.  xxxvii. 
12,  Dan.  vU.  27,  as  well  as  the  passage  in 
Revelations  (xx.  1-7),  were  received  in 
their  literal  meaning  by  such  as  Irenaius, 
Tertullian,  Cyprian,  and  others  (Iren. 
adv.  User.  v.  34;  Tertull.  adv.  Marc.  iii. 
&c. ;  Cyp.  de  Exhurt.  Mart,  ad  Jin.).  But 
there  came  in  sensual  ideas  with  regard  to 
the  millennium,  and  the  Chiliasts  might  be 


MILLENARIANS 


493 


divided  into  two  classes,  the  gross  and  the 
refined.  While  the  latter  expected  at  the  mil- 
lennium the  highest  spiritual  delights,  the 
pleasures  of  sense  not  being  indeed  excluded, 
the  former  looked  for  the  free  indulgence 
of  all  sensual  delights,  and  extreme  lusts. 
Caius,  a  teacher  at  Rome,  seems  to  have 
been  the  first  to  combat  these  pernicious 
ideas,  and  certainly  the  influence  and 
teaching  of  Origen  were  exercised  against 
them  {De  Principiis,  ii.  11).  Later  on, 
St.  Augustine,  among  others,  wrote  against 
the  "  carnal  beatitude  "  expected  by  Millen- 
arians  (De  Civ.  xx.  7).  From  time  to  time 
fantastic  ideas  appeared,  founded  on  this 
doctrine  :  an  agitation  in  the  tenth  century 
was  caused  by  the  notion  that  the  1000 
years  were  to  be  dated  from  the  birth  of 
Christ.  Writers  were  frequently  to  be  found 
upholding  the  Chiliastic  or  Millenarian 
theory ;  but  it  was  greatly  brought  into 
discredit  by  the  fanaticism  of  the  Ana- 
baptists (See  Anabaptists). 

In  England  Millenarian  doctrine,  among 
other  places,  appears  in  Edward  VI.'s  Cate- 
chism :  "  We  long  and  pray  that  it  may  at 
length  come  to  pass  and  be  fulfilled,  that 
Christ  may  reign  with  His  saints  according 
to  God's  promise  ;  that  He  may  live  and  be 
Lord  in  the  world,"  &c.  (Randolph,  Ench. 
Tlieol.  i.  34).  The  believers  in  the  millen- 
nium do  not  form  a  separate  sect. 

II.  The  Millenarian,  as  far  as  can  be 
gathered  from  different  authors,  such  as 
Petersen  (a.d.  1691),  who  is  the  most 
voluminous,  expects  the  following  events, 
and  as  far  as  he  can  infer  their  connexion, 
in  the  following  order  ;  though  that  is  not, 
in  every  instance,  a  point  of  paramount 
importance,  or  absolute  certainty,  on  which 
room  for  the  jMssibility  of  a  different  suc- 
cession of  particulars  may  not  be  allowed  to 
exist. 

1.  The  Gospel  will  be  preached  over  all 
the  world,  and  all  nations  will  be  converted. 
2.  A  second  advent  of  Jesus  Christ  in  person, 
before  His  coming  to  judgment  at  the  end 
of  the  world.  3.  A  conversion  of  the  Jews 
to  Christianity,  collectively,  and  as  a  nation. 
4.  A  resurrection  of  part  of  the  dead,  such 
as  is  called,  by  way  of  distinction,  "the 
resurrection  of  the  just."  5.  The  restitution 
of  the  kingdom  to  Israel,  including  the 
appearance  and  manifestation  of  the  Messiah 
to  the  Jews,  in  the  character  of  a  temporal 
monarch.  6.  A  conformation  of  this  king- 
dom to  a  state  or  condition  of  society  of 
which  Christ  will  be  the  head,  and  faithful 
believers,  both  Jews  and  Gentiles,  will  be 
the  members.  7.  A  distribution  of  rewards 
and  dignities  in  it,  proportioned  to  the  re- 
spective merits  or  good  deserts  of  the  re- 
ceivers. 8.  A  resulting  state  of  things, 
which  though  transacted  upon  earth,  and 


494 


MINIMS 


adapted  to  the  nature  and  conditions  of  a 
human  society  as  such,  leaves  nothing  to 
be  desired  for  its  perfection  and  happiness. 

This  is  what  is  meant  by  the  doctrine 
of  the  Millennium  in  general :  the  fact  of  a 
return  of  Jesus  Christ  in  person  before  the 
end  of  the  world ;  of  a  first  or  particular 
resurrection  of  the  dead ;  of  a  reign  of 
Christ,  with  all  saints,  on  the  earth ;  and  all 
this  before  the  present  state  of  things  is  at 
an  end,  and  before  time  and  sense,  whose 
proper  period  of  being  is  commensurate  with 
the  duration  of  the  present  state  of  things, 
have  given  place  to  spirit  and  eternity  in 
heaven. — ^AValch,  Hist,  der  Ketzereien,  ii. 
136  seq. ;  DoUinger,  Hist,  by  Cox,  i.  194 
Wordswoith,  Gk.  Test,  in  Eev.  xx.  6 
Blunt's  Diet.  ITieol,  s.  v.     [H.] 

MINIMS.  A  religious  order  in  the  Church 
of  Rome,  whose  founder  was  St.  Francis  de 
Paula,  so  called  from  the  place  in  Calabria, 
where  he  was  bom  in  1416. 

He  composed  his  rule  in  1493,  and  it  was 
approved  by  Pope  Alexander  VI.,  at  the  re- 
commendation of  the  king  of  Prance.  This 
pontiff  changed  the  name  of  Hermits  of  St. 
.Francis,  which  these  monks  bore,  into  that 
of  Mioims  (the  Least},  because  they  called 
themselves  in  humility  Minimi  Fratres 
Eremitas,  and  gave  them  all  the  privileges 
of  the  religious  mendicant  or  begging  friars. 
In  1507,  the  founder  of  this  order  died, 
at  the  age  of  ninety-one  years,  and  was 
canonized  by  Pope  Leo  X.,  in  1519.  His 
body  was  preserved  in  the  church  of  the 
convent  of  Plessis,  until  the  Huguenots,  in 
1562,  dragged  it  out  of  its  tomb,  and  burnt 
it  with  the  wood  of  a  crucifix  belonging  to 
the  church.  His  bones,  however,  were 
saved  out  of  the  fire  by  some  zealous 
Catholics  who  mixed  with  the  Calvinist 
soldiers,  and  were  distributed  afterwards 
among  several  churches. 

This  order  is  divided  into  thirty-one 
provinces,  of  which  twelve,  before  the 
suppression  of  the  monastic  orders,  were  in 
Italy,  eleven  in  Prance  and  Planders,  seven 
in  Spain,  and  one  in  Germany.  The 
"  Minims  "  have  passed  even  into  the  Indies, 
where  there  are  some  convents  which  do  not 
compose  provinces,  but  depend  immediately 
on  the  general. 

What  more  particularly  distinguishes 
these  monks  from  all  others,  is  the  observa- 
tion of  what  they  call  the  quadragesimal 
life,  that  is,  a  total  abstinence  from  flesh, 
and  everything  which  has  its  origin  from 
flesh,  as  eggs,  butter,  cheese,  excepting  in 
case  of  great  sickness.  By  this  means  they 
make  the  year  one  continued  Lent  fast. 
Their  habit  is  coarse  black  wooUen  stuff, 
with  a  woollen  girdle  of  the  same  colour, 
tied  in  five  knots.  They  are  not  permitted 
to  quit  their  habit  and  girdle  night  nor  day. 


MINISTER 

Formerly  they  went  barefooted,  but  for  these 
last  hundred  years  they  have  been  allowed 
the  use  of  shoes. 

MINISTER  (Lat.  minister).  One  who 
acts  for  another ;  an  agent.  In  this  sense 
all  who  perform  any  service  for  God  are  His 
ministers,  whether  they  are  clerics  or  lay- 
men acting  as  assistants,  or  officiants  at  the 
Holy  Eucharist  or  other  services.  The 
term  was  applied  generally  to  the  clergy 
about  the  time  of  the  great  Rebellion,  and  it 
has  been  common  ever  since  to  talk  of  the 
"minister"  of  such  and  such  a  parish  or 
church ;  but  the  expression  is  a  misleading 
one,  for  the  clergy  are  the  ministers  or 
agents  not  of  men,  but  of  God,  to  dispense 
His  word  and  sacraments  to  His  people. 
The  word  at  one  time  seems  to  have  been 
considered  equivalent  to  "priest,"  as  it  is 
ordered  "  no  bishop  shall  make  a  person 
deacon  and  minister  both  upon  one  day" 
(Can.  32) ;  but  afterwards  it  came  to  be 
applied  to  clergymen  irrespective  of  their 
order,  and  even  to  dissenting  preachers. 
Puritans  at  the  Savoy  Conference  wanted  to 
substitute  "  minister  "  for  "  priest "  through- 
out the  Prayer  Book.  To  this  the  Commis- 
sioners repUed,  "  Since  some  parts  of  the 
Liturgy  may  be  performed  by  a  deacon, 
others  by  none  under  the  order  of  a  priest 
(viz.  absolution,  consecration),  it  is  fit  that 
some  such  word  as  priest  should  be  used  for 
those  oSices,  and  not  minister,  which  signifies 
at  large  every  one  that  ministers  in  that  holy 
oiBoe,  of  whatsoever  order  he  be "  (See 
Absolution).  The  word,  therefore,  may  be ' 
taken  generally  to  imply  an  assistant, 
whether  presbyteral  or  diaconal,  in  Divine 
service.  Thus  in  the  statutes  of  the  cathe- 
drals of  the  new  foundation,  the  minor 
canons  and  other  members  of  the  choir  are 
called  ministers.  These  represent  the  dea- 
cons, readers,  chanters,  &c.,  of  the  ancient 
Church. 

In  the  Prayer  Book  the  word  minister  is 
prefixed,  in  the  order  both  for  Morning  and 
Evening  Prayer,  to  those  parts  of  the  service 
only  where  there  is  exhortation,  or  in  which 
the  people  audibly  join,  as  in  the  Apostles' 
Creed,  or  which  are  said  kneeling,  such  as  the 
General  Confession,  Lord's  Prayer,  and  Lesser 
Litany.  Minister  also  occurs  in  one  of  the 
rubrics  respecting  the  reading  of  the  lessons, 
which  the  custom  of  the  Church,  both 
Eastern  and  "Western,  has  always  permitted 
to  the  inferior  ministers,  and  to  mere  lay- 
men. The  word  priest  is  prefixed  to  the 
Absolution,  and  to  all  those  prayers  which 
the  clergyman  performs  standing ;  such  as 
the  versicles  before  the  psalms,  beginning  at 
the  Gloria  Patri,  and  those  before  the 
collects.  To  the  collects  themselves  no 
direction  is  prefixed.  There  are  a  few 
exceptions  which    may  be   accounted  for. 


MINOK  CANONS 

Altogether  the  conclusion  must  be  that  the 
rubrics  alone,  apart  from  long  usage,  arc 
insufficient  to  determine  the  question,  and 
that  the  distinction  between  the  terms 
"priest"  and  "minister"  has  not  been 
consistently  maintained.     [H.] 

MINOR  CANONS  (See  Canons). 

MINOR  HOLY-DAYS  — MINOR 
SAINTS'  DAYS.  Before  the  Refonnation 
great  inconvenience  was  found  to  arise  from 
the  number  of  holy-days  in  the  Calendar  on 
which  there  was  cessation  from  work.  In 
the  reign  of  King  Henry  VIIL,  some  changes 
were  made  by  the  "abrogation  of  certain 
holy-days ; "  and  in  the  Prayer  Book  of 
1549  the  principal  names  only  which  had 
been  contained  in  the  Calendar  of  the 
Salisbury  Use  were  inserted.  In  1661  the 
names  of  SS.  Bede,  Alban,  and  Enurchus 
were  added.  It  is  curious  that  SS.  Aidan 
and  Cuthbert,  our  national  saints,  and  St. 
Patrick,  are  left  out  of  the  number  of  minor 
saints  (See  Calendar).     [H.] 

MINORS,  MARRIAGE  OF.  Canon  62 
forbids  such  marriages,  without  consent 
of  the  parents  or  governors  of  the  parties. 
But  Stat.  4  Geo.  IV.  c.  76,  s.  8,  enacts  that 
no  clergyman  shall  be  punishable  for  cele- 
brating the  marriage  of  minors  without 
consent  of  the  parents  or  guardians,  unless 
he  has  had  notice  of  their  dissent.  If  such 
notice  is  openly  declared,  or  caused  to  be 
declared,  at  the  time  of  the  publication  of 
the  banns,  such  publication  becomes  abso- 
lutely void.  When  a  licence  is  brought  to 
the  clergyman  (however  wrongfully  ob- 
tained) he  is  not  legally  responsible.     [H.] 

MINORESS.  A  nun  under  the  rule  of 
St.  Clare. 

MIN  STER.  An  old  word,  always  or  gene- 
rally used  for  some  cathedral  and  collegiate 
churches,  especially  York,  Lincoln,  Ripon, 
Beverley,  Southwell,  and  occasionally  Peter- 
borough, where  the  precincts  are  called 
Minster  Yard.  Wimbome  Minster  and 
Westminster  have  become  the  names  of 
places.  The  name  is  always  said  to  come 
from  monasterium,  which  could  not  well  be 
turned  into  monster.  Perhaps  "  minister  " 
helped  it  into  "  minster."     [G.] 

MIRACLES.  The  credibiHty  of  the 
miracles  of  the  New  Testament  is  the 
primary  theological  question  of  this  age, 
among  those  who  are  not  simple  atheists,  or 
believers  that  the  laws  of  nature  were  self- 
existent  ah  seterno  :  which  means  that  all 
the  atoms  of  matter  were  from  the  begin- 
ning, and  all  resolved  how  they  would 
behave  in  all  possible  circumstances,  and 
have  always  kept  their  resolution  (See 
Sir  E.  Beckett's  Origin  of  the  Laws  of 
Nature).  The  hypothesis  of  a  Creator  of 
"  Persistent  Force  "  only,  and  of  self-existing 
matter,  is  practically  the  same,  and  con- 


MIRACLES 


495. 


fesses  itself  unable  to  account  for  any 
change  into  the  variety  of  forces  that  exist, 
by  calling  such  changes  "unfathomable 
mysteries"  (See  Ed.  Rev.  of  Spencer's 
First  Principles,  Jan.  1884).  Many  theists 
also  disbelieve  miracles,  including  some 
who,  in  some  sense  of  their  own,  call  them- 
selves Christians.  We  can  only  give  a  very 
short  summary  here  of  the  chief  arguments 
on  this  great  question  which  has  occupied 
many  volumes  and  some  of  the  greatest 
writers. 

Whatever  attempts  may  be  made  to 
evade  the  conclusion,  no  definition  of 
miracles  can  be  logically  maintained  except 
that  they  are,  and  throughout  the  Bible 
are  avowed  to  be,  interruptions  of  the  other- 
wise invariable  action  of  the  laws  of  nature- 
by  the  same  power  that  made  them.  The- 
unbelieving  philosophers,  such  as  Pi-ofessor 
Huxley  in  his  life  of  Hume  (see  Review  of 
it  by  Sir  E.  Beckett,  S.  P.  C.  K.),  who  try  to 
reduce  them  to  mere  "  wonders  "  or  "  prodi- 
gies," because  "miraculum  means  something 
wonderful,"  oddly  forget  that  the  New 
Testament  was  not  written  in  Latin,  and 
that  "  miracles  "  are  the  received  translation 
of  tT-qjxcia,  SvvdiifLs,  and  Tcpara,  of  whiclb 
the  last  is  hardly  ever  used  alone,  and  the}' 
are  all  invariably  used  for  "signs"  of 
"divine  power,"  as  the  two  former  words 
import.  If  the  so-called  miracles  were  not 
such  signs,  they  were  nothing  except  con- 
juring impostures,  or  the  stories  of  them 
simply  lies.  For  there  can  be  no  doubt  that 
they  were  asserted  by  those  who  did  them 
or  commanded  or  invoked  them,  to  be  such 
signs,  and  that  the  belief  of  those  who  saw 
them  gradually  converted  all  the  civilized 
and  progressive  nations  of  the  world  to 
Christianity.  We  must  logically  agree 
with  unbelievers  that  nothing  is  to  be 
gained  by  ingenious  changes  of  language 
about  the  "  laws  of  nature,"  the  "  course  of 
nature,"  and  the  like,  to  make  the  inter- 
ferences appear  less.  No  change  of  phrases 
can  get  over  the  fact,  that  it  was  plainly 
an  interference  with  the  laws  of  nature, 
both  as  to  matter  and  force,  if  a  human 
body  ever  walked  on  the  water,  and  finally 
disappeared  into  the  clouds — a  man  who 
had  been  killed  publicly  by  those  who 
understood  the  business,  and  buried,  rose 
again  on  the  third  day  after  it,  and  took  a 
long  walk  into  the  country — ^if  six  pots  of 
water  were  turned  into  the  best  wine  by  a 
word — if  5000  and  4000  people  were  fed  in 
the  wilderness  by  a  few  loaves  and  small 
fishes,  which  a  lad  had  brought  with  him — 
if  multitudes  of  people  were  suddenly 
cured  of  all  manner  of  diseases  and  defects 
by  the  mere  word  of  a  man,  whether  human 
or  divine — if  prophecies  by  that  same 
person  of  the  exact  and  unlikely  method  of 


49G 


MIRACLES 


his  death,  as  he  had  not  offended  the 
Bomans,  and  of  his  resurrection,  and  of 
the  destruction  of  that  great  city  where  he 
lived,  were  fulfilled — and  other  tilings 
which  every  man  of  common  sense  knows 
to  he  impossible  from  natural  causes  (See 
Belcher  on  Our  Lord's  Miracles  of  Healing, 
and  Trench  on  the  Miracles).  Ingenious 
and  well-meant  attempts  to  get  over  all 
this  by  saying  that  these  things  may 
possibly  have  been  within  the  range  of 
some  wider  but  unknown  laws  of  nature, 
like  what  mathematicians  call  "conjugate 
IMints,"  really  belonging  to  some  curve 
though  quite  outside  of  it,  are  incapable 
of  convincing  any  unwilling  hearer,  though 
they  may  look  plausible  to  willing  ones. 
And  they  are  worse,  because  if  they  were 
so,  the  miracles  were,  afier  all,  not  signs 
of  any  divine  power,  and  Christ  and  the 
apostles  knew  it,  if  they  themselves  were 
what  they  professed  to  be;  so  that  either 
way  they  were  gross  deceivers  if  the  miracles 
were  not  divine  interferences  over-riding 
the  laws  of  nature  for  the  time,  though 
the  laws  remained  unaltered. 

Another  preliminary  admission  must  be 
made,  or  rather,  in  truth,  a  fundamental 
assertion  for  Chiistianity,  which  may  be 
summed  up  in  one  sentence  of  Dr.  Salmon's 
Non-miraculous  Christianity,  which  he 
well  says  "is  as  much  a  contradiction  in 
terms  as  a  quadrangular  circle."  For  Christi- 
anity was  not  only  established  by  miracles,  as 
its  author  said,  but  is  ipso  facto  the  belief  in 
the  three  great  miracles,  of  Christ's  birth  with- 
out a  human  father.  His  resurrection,  and  His 
ascension.  If  these  were  not  what  the  New 
Testament  records,  there  is  no  such  religion 
as  Christianity,  but  only  one  more  system 
of  moral  philosophy,  of  which  different 
people  have  a  right  to  accept  just  as  much 
as  they  happen  to  be  convinced  of  by  or- 
dinary argument,  if  it  cannot  be  proved  to 
be  divine,  which  it  certainly  cannot  without 
miracles  to  connect  it  with  the  only  supreme 
iwwer  over  the  universe  and  the  laws  of 
nature.  A  favourite  saying  of  modern 
infidels  is  true  enough  in  a  proper  sense,  viz. 
"  that  Christianity  was  first  believed  on  the 
.strength  of  miracles,  and  now  miracles  on 
the  strength  of  Christianity,"  which  is  in- 
tended by  them  to  look  like  reasoning  in  a 
circle,  and  therefore  no  reasoning  at  all.  But 
this,  like  most  of  their  sayings  of  that  kind, 
is  a  mere  verbal  fallacy  or  trick.  It  really 
means  that  after  nineteen  centuries  of  trans- 
mitted belief  in  the  three  miraculous  facts 
of  which  Christianity  consists,  which  were 
originally  proved  by  a  multitude  of  other 
miracles  besides,  we  need  not  set  to  work  over 
a,gain  to  prove  them  individually.  When 
any  proposition  or  fact  has  been  proved  once 
in  the  only  way  it  admits  of,  it  is  proved 


MIRACLES 

for  ever.  The  miracles  were  proved  once 
for  all  to  the  conviction  of  those  who  saw 
them ;  for  they  were  not  even  denied  by 
those  whom  they  did  not  convert.  Attri- 
buting them  to  Beelzebub  was  an  admission 
that  they  were  supernatural  events,  and  not 
mere  fictions  or  tricks.  The  Jews  did  not 
seek  to  kill  both  Jesus  and  Lazarus  because 
Lazarus  was  not  raised  from  the  dead,  but 
because  he  was :  at  any  rate  they  could 
invent  no  other  explanation,  though  for 
other  reasons  most  of  them  would  not 
believe  Jesus  to  be  the  Son  of  God.  Even 
if  no  records  of  the  individual  miracles  from 
the  hands  of  contemporary  writers  survived, 
it  would  be  perfectly  good  reasoning  to  hold 
that  they  are  now  sufficiently  proved  by  the 
notorious  fact  that  Christianity  was  esta- 
blished by  them;  and  that  is  one  answer 
to  the  infidel  saying  that  we  now  believe 
the  miracles  on  the  strength  of  Christianity 
— which  but  for  them  could  never  have 
existed.  But  besides  that,  the  records  of 
contemporary  writers  do  survive,  on  which 
evidential  books  have  been  written  which 
never  will  be  obsolete,  and  never  have  been 
rationally  answered ;  for  neither  sneering 
nor  a  priori  dicta  about  impossibilities  are 
any  answers  at  all.  If  the  existence  of 
Christianity,  and  its  general  acceptance  by 
all  the  civilised  nations  of  the  world,  can  be 
rationally  accounted  for  without  the  mira- 
cles having  been  real,  let  it  be :  but  it 
never  has  been  yet ;  nor  has  any  theory  for 
it  been  invented  which  a  dozen  people  worth 
naming  have  concurred  in  adopting.  And 
that  is  absolutely  decisive.  Christianity  is 
the  phenomenon  now  to  be  accounted  for. 
The  truth  of  the  miracles  does  account  for 
it  completely  ;  and  if  nothing  else  does,  the 
question  is  decided  in  favour  of  them  both, 
on  the  strictest  scientific  principles,  unless 
miracles  can  be  somehow  demonstrated  to 
be  impossible.  All  the  pretended  proofs  of 
that  amount  to  nothiug  more  than  that 
they  are  improbable,  and  indeed  impossible 
without  supernatural  interference.  But  that 
of  itself  can  never  be  proved  to  be  im- 
possible. All  the  pretended  proofs  of  it  are 
mere  verbal  trickery,  of  first  using  the  word 
Nature  in  the  common  sense,  and  then  in  a 
new  and  artificial  one,  for  everything  that  is, 
in  heaven  or  earth.  It  is  no  answer  to  all  this 
to  say  that  many  false  religions  exist  and 
claim  some  supernatural  origin,  and  some  of 
them  profess  to  have  had  miracles  at  some 
time.  Some  that  have  existed  are  utterly 
dead  already.  Not  one  of  them  even  professes 
to  be  founded  on  miracles,  beyond  mere  as- 
sertions of  revelations,  of  which  nothing  fit 
to  be  called  evidence,  and  much  less  proof, 
was  ever  given.  Many  are  transparent  non- 
sense which  no  rational  person  thinks  worth 
refuting.     There  is  no  religion  in  the  world 


MIKACLES 

except  Christianity  and  Judaism,  as  far  as 
it  goes  in  the  same  direction,  with  any 
kind  of  demonstration  of  its  origin  or 
authority.  The  alleged  miracles  of  Popery, 
even  if  they  were  true,  would  not  prove  the 
truth  of  the  special  doctrines  of  Rome. 
Transubstantiation  would  indeed  be  a 
miracle  every  time  it  takes  place  if  it  could 
be  proved  ;  but  unfortunately  the  very  same 
evidence  of  our  senses  which  proved  all  the 
miracles  of  Christ  and  the  apostles,  goes 
just  the  other  way  against  transubstantiation. 
Every  absurd  story  about  the  Virgin  Mary 
might  conceivably  be  true,  and  yet  would 
not  the  least  prove  that  she  has  the  power  or 
influence  over  her  Son  in  heaven  which  she 
never  had  on  earth,  or  that  she  was  bom 
without  sin,  as  the  last  Pope  decreed.  No 
miracle  has  ever  proved  either  that  purgatory 
exists,  or  that  Eoman  priests  have  keys  of 
it  if  it  does,  or  that  any  or  all  the  saints  in 
heaven  have.  Nor  has  any  miracle  ever 
gone  an  inch  towards  proving  the  supremacy 
of  the  Pope  or  the  Eoman  Church,  or  that 
he  is  any  more  infallible  than  our  primates. 
So  it  is  really  not  worth  while  to  scrutinise 
the  Popish  miracles  in  detail.  They  have 
the  two  fundamental  defects  of  proving 
nothing  that  they  ought  to  prove,  and  of 
being  themselves  unproved  by  any  evidence 
that  will  stand  examination,  besides  so 
many  of  them  being  transparent  frauds  and 
absurdities  as  to  put  them  all  out  of  court  or 
beyond  the  necessity  of  refutation.  It  is 
sometimes  said  that  there  is  as  much  need 
of  miracles  now  as  ever  to  convince  un- 
believers; and  that  as  they  do  not  come 
now  that  they  are  so  much  needed,  it  is  an 
additional  reason  for  believing  that  they 
never  did  really,  and  that  our  present  ex- 
perience is  conclusive  as  to  all  the  past. 
But  this  also  is  illogical.  There  is  not  the 
same  need  of  them  now  as  there  was  when 
Christianity  had  to  be  established  by  them. 
It  is  established,  and  the  miracles  of  Christ 
did  the  work  He  said  they  would.  They 
did  not  convince  all  who  saw  them  then, 
and  He  never  said  they  would,  but  always 
assumed  or  said  that  there  would  be  many 
unbelievers,  until  the  end  comes.  "  If  they 
bear  not  Moses  and  the  prophets,  neither 
will  they  be  persuaded,  though  one  rose 
from  the  dead,"  is  true  now  that  One  has 
risen  from  the  dead.  And  as  the  circum- 
stances of  the  world  are  different  now, 
since  Christianity  exists,  there  is  no  reason 
for  saying  that  our  present  experience  of 
the  absence  of  miracles  proves  anything 
at  all  as  to  the  time  when  Christianity  haxl 
to  be  established  by  them. 

Occasional  instances  of  fulfilled  predic- 
tions by  what  is  called  second-sight,  or  some 
other  occult  means,  which  no  one  takes  for 
divine  revelations,   although  they    cannot 


MIRACLES 


497 


all  be  refuted  or  explained,  prove  nothing 
against  the  fulfilled  prophecies  of  Scripture 
which  are  on  a  much  larger  scale ;  and  such 
prophecies  were  miracles  if  they  turned  out 
true.  Nor  has  there  ever  been  anything 
analogous  to  that  combination  of  prediction 
and  miracle,  or  even  of  things  which  would 
not  be  miraculous  without  the  prediction  of 
them,  which  is  characteristic  of  the  great 
majority  of  the  Bible  miracles.  Multitudes 
of  people  in  all  ages  have  died  suddenly — 
been  swallowed  up  by  earthquakes — become 
blind — been  cured  of  diseases,  though  not  of 
death ;  but  never  anywhere  else  have  those 
events  followed  the  declarations  of  men 
that  they  were  going  to  happen  immedi- 
ately. It  is  too  often  forgotten  that  the 
"doers"  of  miracles  did  nothing  except 
command  or  predict  or  invoke  them ;  which 
puts  them  out  of  the  range  of  conjuring,  if 
any  such  conjuring  were  possible. 

What  then  do  the  modern  refusals  to 
consider  the  evidence  for  the  Christian 
miracles  all  come  to?  They  all  resolve 
themselves  into  two  :  one,  the  repetition  in 
various  terms  of  Hume's  often-exposed 
paradox  that  it  is  more  probable  that  the 
original  witnesses  lied  than  that  the  universal 
experience  against  miracles  was  broken 
during  one  short  period  of  the  world,  with 
a  few  former  occasional  exceptions,  as  of 
the  0.  T.  That  proposition  has  been 
amended  and  enlarged  by  Mr.  Huxley  in 
his  little  book  on  Hume,  and  Hume's  con- 
ditions for  an  admissible  proof  of  miracles 
adopted  and  insisted  on.  For  answers  to  that 
revised  version  of  Hume's  theory  we  must 
refer  to  the  above  -  mentioned  Eevieiu 
of  Hume  and  Huxley  on  Miracles,  which 
shows  how  it  involves  the  common  fallacy 
of  using  such  words  as  "nature"  and 
"experience"  in  double  senses,  by  which 
any  proposition  that  you  like  can  be 
apparently  proved.  The  other  and  more 
fashionable  objection  just  now  is  that 
science  has  proved  the  laws  of  nature  to  be 
inviolably  uniform,  and  the  sam.  of  all 
the  forces  in  the  universe,  and  of  all  the 
matter  therein,  to  be  constant,  so  that  such 
miracles  cannot  possibly  have  happened. 
But  science  has  proved  nothing  of  the  kind. 
No  scientific  Christian  has  any  doubt,  nor 
had  Newton  or  Faraday,  or  any  other 
Christian  philosopher,  that  the  laws  of 
nature  are  uniform  and  inviolable  by  anj^ 
power  except  that  which  made  them ;  and 
also  that  He  never  does  so  (as  far  as  we 
can  tell)  without  some  special  motive  of 
sufficient  importance.  In  other  words, 
science  has  only  proved  that  there  is 
nothing  miraculous  except  mirades;  that 
all  experience  is  against  them  except  that 
experience  which  included  them,  and  which 
is  iust  as  much  entitled  to  consideration  as 

2  K 


498 


MIEACLES 


all  the  other  experience,  on  the   strictest 
scientific  principles.     A  theory  which  per- 
sists in  ignoring  proved  facts  is  "  condemned 
already,"  and  would  not  be  listened  to  in 
any  other  case.     The  laws   of  nature,  in- 
cluding that  of  the  conservation  of  force 
of  which  infidels  make  so  much,  are  not 
necessaiy  truths  like  those  of  arithmetic 
and  geometry,  the  violation  of  which  is  not 
only  improbable  but  inconceivable  by  our 
minds,  or  is  absolute  nonsense.     They  are 
only  statements  of  the  results  of  aU  kiaown 
ordinary  experiences,  or  scientific  knowledge 
of  causes  and  effects  iu  all  ordinary  circum- 
stances.    The  moment  the  Creator  of  the 
laws  of  nature  had  a  sufficient  reason  of  His 
own  to  act  against  a  law  of  nature,  the 
circumstances  ceased  to  be  ordinary,  though 
we  have  (now)  no  such  experience.     What 
the  infidels  have  to  do  as  mere  philosophers, 
and  have  never  done,  is  to  frame  a  theory 
which  explains  all  the  phsenomena,  of  the 
existence  of  Christianity  and  its  records  of 
the  apparently  miraculous  facts,  by  some- 
thing better  than  the  slovenly  and    un- 
philosophical  assertion  that  they  refuse  to 
consider  at  all  one  whole  class  of  phenomena 
which  no  reasonable  man  can   doubt  hap- 
pened somehow,  whether  supernatural  or 
not.     If  they  can  prove  aU  those  records  to 
be  false,  consistently  with  the  existence  of 
Christianity,   let  them.    But  saying  that 
they  must  be  false  merely  because  they  are 
unique,  is   saying  nothing,  and  would  be 
laughed  at  in  any  other  matter  as  contrary 
to  the  first  principles  of  scientific  reasoning. 
Tt    has    been    shown    too,    and  strangely 
enough,  by   Babbage,   who    never    passed 
for  a  believer  in  Christianity  or  miracles, 
that    even    as    a    piece    of   mathematical 
reasoning,  Hume's  paradox  was  wrong ;  for 
that  the  concurrence  of  a  very  moderate 
number  of  witnesses  of  average  veracity  as 
to  an  event  within  their  own  knowledge  is 
mathematically  sufficient  to  prove  the  most 
unhkely  thing  that  can  be  imagined,  short 
of   mathematical    impossibility.      On    the 
whole  therefore  we  defy  these  deniers  of 
miracles  to  refute    the    following  conclu- 
sions : — first,  that  any  attempt    to  throw 
over    miracles  and  yet  keep  the  religion 
which  is  founded  on  them,  is  like  pretend- 
ing to  discover  "  a  quadrangular  circle ; " 
secondly,  that  science   or  the    knowledge 
of  natural  causes  and  effects  has  nothing 
to   say    to    supernatural    ones,    and  that 
events  plainly  contrary  to    the    laws    of 
nature  must  be  due  to  a  supernatural  cause 
or  power:   thirdly,  if  the  miracles  them- 
selves tended  to  prove  supernatural  power 
in  the  principal  doer  of  them,  and  super- 
natm-al  support  or  inspiration  of  those  who 
followed  Him  and  said  that  they  did  them 
in  His  name,  or  in  proof  of  His  doctrine,  the 


SnSSAL 

case  is  complete,  unless  the  whole  story  of 
the  New   Testament  can   be  evidentially 
proved  to  have  been  a  mass  of  forgeries. 
And  even  Huxley  admits  that  there  is  no 
phenomenon  of  which    some    amount    of 
evidence  would  not  convince  him ;  only  he 
would  not  admit  it  to  be  supernatural : 
which  is  perfectly  right  if  he  could  frame  a 
rational  theory  for  explaining  it  consistently 
with  nature,  which  neither  he   nor  any- 
body else  has  ever  done  with  the  Christian 
miracles.  The  miiltitude  of  theories  for  trying 
to  explain  their  history  away,  and  the  trans- 
parent absurdity  of  most  of  them,  are  alone 
conclusive    against    such    theories.      This 
of  course  is   only  a  very  short  summary 
of  the  principal  arguments  for  miracles, 
and  we    must    refer    to    the    well-known 
works  of  Paley,  Lardner,  Butler,  Mansel, 
Salmon,     Mozley,     and    other     eminent 
writers,  both  as  to  the  actual  evidence  for  the 
Christian  miracles,  and  for  answers  to  the 
infidel  attempts  to  prove  their  impossibility 
on  what  are  called  a  priori  grounds.     [G.] 
MIRACLE-PLAYS  (See  Moralities). 
MISCHNA,  or   MISHNA.     The  tradi- 
tional   exposition    of   the    law.      Various 
derivations  have  been  given,  but  the  most 
probable  is  that  which  refers  to  the  word 
"  Sheni,"   "  second " — the  Mishna  or  oral 
law  being  second  to  the  written  law.    It  is 
believed  by  the  Jews  to  be  the  tradition 
delivered,  unwritten,  to  Moses  by  God ;  and 
preserved  only  by  the  doctors  of  the  syn- 
agogue tm  the  time  of  Eabbi  Judas  the 
Holy,  who  committed  it  to  writing  about 
A.D.   180.     It  is  in  fact  the  canon    and 
civO  law  of  the  Jews;   treating  of  tithes, 
festivals,  matrimonial  laws,  mercantile  laws, 
idolatry,  oaths,  sacrifices,  and  purifications. 
The  heads  of  the  synagogue,  who  are  said  to 
have  preserved  the  Mishna,  were  thought 
to  have  had  the  privilege  of  hearing  the 
Bath- Col,  or  oracular  voice  of  God  (See 
Bath-Cot).      The    Mishna     contains    the 
text ;  and  the  Gemara,  which  is  the  second 
part  of  the  Talmud,  contains  the  commen- 
taries ;  so  that  the  Gemara  is,  as  it  were,  a 
glossary  to  the  Mishna. 

MISERERE.  The  seat  of  a  stall,  so 
contrived  as  to  turn  up  and  down,  according 
as  it  is  wanted  as  a  high  support  in  long 
standing,  or  as  an  ordinary  seat.  Misereres 
are  almost  always  carved,  and  often  very 
richly ;  more  often  too  than  any  other  part 
of  the  wood-work,  with  grotesques. 
MISSA  (See  Mass). 

MISSA  SICCA  (Lit.  Dry  Mass).  A  term 
used  in  the  Roman  Church  to  imply  the  or- 
dinary part  of  the  office  without  the  canon, 
there  being  neither  consecration  nor  commu- 
nion.— Durandus,  Ration,  iv.,  i.  23.     [H.] 

MISSAL  (See  Mass).  The  office  book 
of  the   Western   Church,  containing    the 


MISSION 

-whole  Liturgy,  the  final  "  Ordinary "  and 
■"  Canon  "  of  the  Mass,  with  the  changeable 
Introits,  Collects,  Epistles,  Gospels,  &c. 
In  the  ancient  Church,  the  several  parts  of 
Divine  service  were  arranged  in  distinct 
books.  Thus  the  Collects  and  the  inva- 
riable portion  of  the  Communion  Office 
formed  the  book  called  the  Sacramentary. 
The  lessons  from  the  Old  and  New  Testa- 
ments constituted  the  Lectionary,  and  the 
Gospels  made  another  volume,  with  the 
title  of  Evangdistarium.  The  Antiphonary 
consisted  of  anthems,  &c.,  designed  for 
•chanting. 

About  the  eleventh  or  twelfth  century  it 
was  found  convenient,  generally,  to  unite 
these  books,  and  the  volume  obtained  the 
name  of  the  Complete  or  Plenary  Missal,  or 
Book  of  Missai.  Of  this  description  were 
almost  all  the  liturgical  books  of  the 
Western  Churches,  and  the  arrangement  is 
still  preserved  in '  our  own.  There  was 
considerable  Variation  in  the  Missals  of 
different  Churches,  those  of  the  Anglican 
branch  being  known  by  the  names  of  the 
Sarum  Use,  Hereford  Use,  Lincoln  Use, 
York  Use,  Bangor  Use,  &c.  Our  Prayer 
Book  may  be  said  to  be  founded  on  the 
Sarum  Use  (See  Prayer  Booh).  The 
Koman  Missal  was  not  used  by  Romanists 
in  this  country  till  a.d.  1740,  when  the 
Jesuits  would  not  permit  any  other  to  be 
used ;  before  that  the  Sarum  Use  continued 
to  be  followed,  and  in  forsaking  this, 
Romanists  in  England  surrendered  the  last 
link  of  connexion  with  the  Old  National 
Church.  For  the  editions  of  the  Sarum 
Mis.sal  see  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  1.  Ixix.  Ixxxii. 
■(1882) ;  Dayman's  edition  of  the  Sarum 
Missals.  James  IJ.'s  Sarum  Missal  is  pre- 
served in  Worcester  Cathedral  Library. — 
Palmer's  Orig.  Liturg.  i.  iii.  308 ;  Krazer, 
de  Liturg.  sec.  ii.  c.  2-6 ;  Blunt,  Diet.  Doct. 
Theol.    [H.] 

MISSION.  Lit,  a  sending :  hence  a 
commission  to  preach  the  gospel.  Thus  our 
blessed  Lord  gave  His  apostles  and  their 
successors  the  bishops  their  mission,  when 
He  said,  "  Go  ye  into  all  the  world,  and 
preach  the  gospel  to  every  creature." 

It  certainly  is  essential  that  the  true 
ministers  of  God  should  be  able  to  prove 
that  they  have  not  only  the  power,  but  the 
right  of  performing  sacred  offices.  There 
is  an  evident  difference  between  these 
things,  as  may  be  seen  by  the  following 
cases.  If  a  regularly  ordained  priest  should 
celebrate  the  Eucharist  in  the  church  of 
another,  contrary  to  the  will  of  that  person 
and  of  the  bishop,  he  would  have  the 
power  of  consecrating  the  Eucharist,  and  it 
actually  would  be  consecrated ;  but  he  would 
not  have  the  rigid  of  consecrating ;  or,  in 
other  words,  he  would  not  have  mission  for 


MISSIONARY 


409 

--JO. 


that  act.  If  a  bishop  should  enter  the 
diocese  of  another  bisihop,  and,  contrary  to 
his  will,  ordain  one  of  his  deacons  to  the 
priesthood,  the  intruding  bishop  would  have 
the  power,  but  not  the  right,  of  ordain- 
ing ;  he  would  have  no  mission  for  such  an 
act.  In  fact,  mission  fails  in  all  schismatical, 
heretical,  and  uncanonical  acts,  because 
God  cannot  have  given  any  man  a  right 
to  act  in  opposition  to  those  laws  which  He 
himself  has  enacted,  or  to  those  which  the 
apostles  and  their  successors  have  insti- 
tuted, for  the  orderly  and  peaceable  regu- 
lation of  the  Church  :  He  "  is  not  the  author 
of  confusion,  but  of  peace,  as  in  all  the 
churches  of  the  saints "  (1  Cor.  xiv.  33) ; 
and  yet,  were  He  to  commission  His  minis- 
ters to  exercise  their  offices  in  whatever 
places  and  circumstances  they  pleased,  con- 
fusion and  division  without  end  must  be 
the  inevitable  result.  All  ordinations  and 
consecrations  in  England  not  in  accordance 
with  the  law  are  invalid,  except  so  far  as 
they  may  be  allowed  afterwards  under 
various  Acts  of  Parliament.  (See  Law  of 
Church  in  the  Colonies  and  Scotland.) 

Mission  can  only  be  given  for  acts  in 
accordance  with  the  Divine  and  ecclesias- 
tical laws,  the  latter  of  which  derive  their 
authority  from  the  former ;  and  it  is  con- 
ferred by  valid  ordination.  It  would  be 
easy  to  prove  this  in  several  ways ;  but  it 
is  enough  at  present  to  say,  that  no  other 
method  can  be  pointed  out  by  which  mis- 
sion is  given.  Should  the  ordination  be 
valid,  and  yet  uncanonical,  mission  does 
not  take  effect  until  the  suspension  imposed 
by  the  canons  on  the  person  ordained  is  in 
some  lawful  manner  removed. 

I'he  English  bishops  and  clergy  alone 
properly  have  mission  in  England. — Palmer's 
Orig.  Liturg.  ii.  246. 

MISSIONS  (See  Church  in  Colonies, 
■Societies,  Chuxch).  ' 

MISSIONS,  PAROCHIAL.  In  many 
dioceses  there  are  organisations  for  promo- 
tion of  missions  to  places  where  there  seems 
special  need  of  arousing  people  to  more 
spirituality  of  hfe.  They  are  intended  to 
supplement  the  parochial  system,  with  the 
aid  of  specially  appointed  ministers.  A 
great  number  of  missions  have  been  held 
lately,  and  especially  must  be  mentioned 
the  great  mission  in  London,  1884-5.  A 
Hst  of  missions  and  of  missionaries  is  given 
in  the  Official  Year  Book  of  the  Church  of 
England,  1886,  p.  78  seq.     [H.] 

MISSIONARY.  A  clergyman,  whether 
bishop,  priest,  or  deacon,  deputed  or  sent 
out  by  ecclesiastical  authority,  to  preach 
the  gospel,  and  exercise  his  other  func- 
tions, in  places  where  the  Church  has 
hitherto  been  unknown,  or  is  in  the  in- 
fancy of  its  establishment. 

2  K  2 


500 


MITEE 


MITRE  (fitrpa).  The  Episcopal  coro- 
net. I.  Originally  tlie  word  meant  first  a 
girdle,  and  secondly  a  head-dress,  and  is 
mentioned  by  heathen  writers  as  worn  by 
women,  as  well  as  men  CVirg.  JEJn.  ix. 
616;  Eurip.  Bacch.  833).  It  is  derived 
probably  from  the  same  root  as  filros,  a 
thread,  and  would  primarily  signify  any- 
thing to  be  bound  on  the  person.  The  LXX. 
gives  iiirpa  and  also  KiSapis,  for  the  cap  worn 
by  the  high  priest  mentioned  in  Exodus  and 
elsewhere  (Exod.  xxviii.,  xxix. ;  Lev. 
viii.  9,  &c.).  But  it  is  impossible  to  say 
anything  positive  with  regard  to  official 
head-dresses  worn  by  clerics  in  the  early 
Church,  if  indeed  there  were  any.  It  has 
been  asserted  that  St.  John,  and  also  St. 
James,  wore  mitres,  and  indeed  Polycrates, 
quoted  by  Eusebius,  in  the  one  case,  and 
Epiphanius  in  the  other,  speaks  of  these 
apostles  wearing  ornaments  on  their  heads 
(Polyc.  aj>.  Euseb.  H.  E.  lib.  5,  c.  24; 
Jerom.  de  Vit.  lllust.  c.  45 ;  Epiphan.  Eieres. 
29,  m.  4).  But  the  word  used  is  iriToKov, 
and  this  means  merely  the  ornament  or 
golden  plate  which  they  would  be  entitled 
to  wear  as  being  of  the  family  of  Aaron ; 
and  this  reason  is  also  given  by  Valesius  in 
speaking  of  St.  Mark.  "  13.  Marcum  juxta 
ritum  carnalis  sacrificii,  pontificalis  apicis 
petalum  gestasse  .  .  .  syngraphaj  decla- 
rant ;  ex  quo  manifeste  datur  intelligi,  de 
stirpe  eum  Levitica,  imo  pontificis  Aaron 
sacra;  successionis  originem  natuisse." 
Gregory  Nazianzen  speaks  of  the  "  KiSapis," 
and  Latin  writers  used  the  word  "  infula " 
to  denote  some  kind  of  head-dress  (Greg. 
Naz.  Orat.  x.  4;  Ducange,  s.  v.  in/ula). 
Some  assert  that  the  word  "  corona,"  or  the 
fact  that  the  bishops  were  sometimes 
addressed  "  per  coronam "  implies  the  use 
of  the  episcopal  mitre  (Spondanus,  Epit. 
Baron,  an  58,  n.  54 ;  Hefele's  essay,  Ir^ul. 
Mitra,  &c.).  But  the  above  names  may 
have  been  given  to  any  head-dress,  and 
not  especially  to  those  episcopal  or  even 
ecclesiastical.  Cardinal  Bona  draws  a  dis- 
tinction between  the  mitre  properly  so 
called,  and  some  other  ornament  of  the 
head  worn  from  primitive  ages  (7?er.  Idt.  i., 
cxxiv);  but  there  is  no  mention,  Menard 
says,  of  the  mitre  in  the  ancient  pontificals, 
nor  in  therituahsts  before  the  tenth  century, 
neither  by  Alcuin  nor  Amalarius  {Notes  to 
the  Sacramentary  of  Gregory,  557).  There 
is,  then,  no  proof  of  the  mitre  being  in  use 
in  the  first  ten  centuries  of  the  Christian 
era ;  in  fact,  there  is  no  trustworthy  evidence 
of  its  use  till  a.d.  1049,  when  Leo  IX.  placed 
on  the  head  of  Eberhard,  archbishop  of 
Treves,  the  Roman  mitre. — Patrol,  cxliii. 
595. 

II.  The  first  mitres  were  very  low  and 
simple,  being  not  more  than  from  three  to 


MIXED  CHALICE 

six  inches  in  elevation,  and  they  thus  con- 
tinued till  the  end  of  the  thirteenth  cen- 
tury. In  the  fourteenth  century  they 
gradually  increased  in  height  to  a  foot  or 
more,  and  became  more  superbly  enriched ; 
their  contours  also  presented  a  degree  of 
convexity  by  which  they  were  distinguished 
from  the  old  mitres.  During  the  middle 
ages  there  were  three  kinds  of  mitres  in  use 
among  the  English  bishops :  one  covered 
with  gems  and  precious  stones,  and  with 
gold  or  silver  plates;  the  second  made  of 
white  damask  studded  with  small  pearls, 
and  ornamented  with  gold  threads ;  the 
third,  called  simplex,  made  of  damasked 
silk  or  white  linen  {Cxrimoniale  Episc.  i., 
cxvii.).  The  two  horns  of  the  mitre  are 
generally  taken  to  be  an  allusion  to  the 
cloven  tongues  as  of  fire,  which  rested  on 
each  of  the  apostles  on  the  day  of  Pentecost. 
But  Innocent  III.  gives  them  another 
signification.  "  Mitra  pontificis  scientiam 
utriusque  testamenti  significat ;  nam  duo 
cornua  duo  sunt  testamenta,"  &c.  (Lib.  i.,. 
c.  xliv.). 

Mitres,  although  worn  in  some  of  the 
Lutheran  Churches  (as  in  Sweden),  have 
tin  lately  fallen  into  desuetude  in  England,, 
even  at  coronations.  They  were  worn 
however  at  the  coronations  of  Edward  VL 
and  Queen  Elizabeth.  See  Eierurgia 
Anglicana,  p.  81,  seq. ;  in  which  work, 
however,  at  p.  89,  there  is  an  assertion  of 
Dr.  Milner's,  which  is  incorrect,  viz.  that 
they  were  worn  at  the  coronation  of 
George  III.;  and  this  mistake  is  followed 
by  Walcott.  In  the  detailed  accounts  ot 
that  ceremony  (see  e.g.  the  Annual  Register 
for  1761)  the  bishops  are  described  as  carry- 
ing their  square  caps,  and  putting  them  on 
when  the  lay  peers  assumed  their  coronets. 
This  disuse  of  the  mitre  seems  only  to  date 
from  the  eighteenth  century.  Mitres  and 
staves  of  silver,  gilt  were  carried  at  the 
funerals  of  Juxon,  Duppa,  Prewen,  Cosin, 
Wren,  Trelawny,  and  Lindsay  (1724); 
mitres  only  at  the  burials  of  Monk  and 
Feme.  The  mitres  of  Trelawny  and  Mew& 
are  preserved  in  Winchester  Cathedral. — 
Bingham,  ii.,  ix.  5 ;  Martene,  de  Bit.  i.  c.  4 ; 
Marriott,  Vest.  airist.\<^.  187-220;  Maskell, 
Mon.  Bit.  Ecd.  Ang.  ii.  290 ;  Walcott,  Sac, 
Arch.  p.  383.     [H.] 

MIXED  CHALICE.  There  is  no  doubt 
that  from  the  very  earliest  times  it  was 
customary  to  mix  water  with  the  wine  at 
the  Holy  Eucharist,  and  that  it  continued 
to  be  so,  except  in  the  Armenian  Church, 
for  1500  years.  It  was  generally  the 
custom  among  the  Jews  to  mix  water 
with  the  wine  in  the  Paschal  cup  (Mai- 
monides,  lib.  de  Solemn.  Pascli.  c.  7) :  and 
there  seems  to  be  little  doubt  that  the  cup 
our    Lord    Himself    blessed    contained    a 


MODUS  DECIMANDI 

similar   mixture  (Jolinsou's    Unbl.   Sacrif. 
pt.  ii.  c.  1,  vol.  ii.  pp.  84,   203).     By  tlie 
Fathers,  constant  reference  is  made  to  tlie 
practice,  from  Justin  Martj-r  (who  was  slain 
in  1C5,  at  75   years    of   age)   downwards. 
ETTfira    irpotr^c'pfTat     reo     TrpofOTmTt     tS>v 
ao£\(fiS>v    apros     Koi     TroTrjpiov     vSotos     koI 
KpdfiaTos    (Justin    M.    Apol.    i.) :   so  also 
St.  Ireuajus  (lib.   v.  c.  2),  Clemens  Alex. 
(^Paid.  lib.  ii.  c.  2),  St.  Cyprian  in  many 
l)laces,  St.  Cyril,  and  many  others.     Where 
heresy  came  in,  it  was  with  regard  to  using 
water  without  wine,  not  wine  without  water 
(see  AguaHi).    The  Armenians   were  the 
first  who  prohibited  the  mixture  of  water 
with  the  wine.     This  was  condemned  in  the 
Council  of  Trullo,  a.d.  691.     In  all  the  in- 
ventories that  are  found  of  church  articles, 
vessels  for  containing  water  as  well  as  for 
wine  have  been  mentioned.     The  mixture 
is  intended  to  symboUze  the  union  of  the 
human  with  the  Divine  nature  in  the  In- 
carnation; and  also  to  commemorate  Him 
Who  for  us  did  shed  out  of  His  side  both 
water  and  blood.     Cranmer  said  that  it  also 
signified  "the  union  of  Christ's   strength 
(vith   the  weakness  of  His  people."     "  It 
must  be  confessed,"  says  Wheatly,  "  that 
the  mixture  has  in  all  ages  been  the  general 
practice,  and  for  that  reason  was  enjoined  to 
be  continued  in  our  Church  by  the  first 
Reformers  ;  and  though  in  the  next  Review 
the  order  for  it  was  omitted,  yet  the  practice 
of  it  was  continued   in  the  King's  Chapel 
all  the  time  that  Bishop  Andrewes  was  Dean 
of  it ;  who  also,  in  a  form  that  he  drew  up 
for  the  consecration  of  a  church,  &c.,  ex- 
pressly directs  and  orders  it  to  be  used." 
Ancient  and  Catholic  though  it  is,  it  has 
not  been  considered  absolutely  essential  to 
the  consecration.   Bona  writes  that  although 
it  is  the  opinion  of  some  that  the  mixture  is 
necessary,  "  certa  est  theologorum  sententia, 
omissa  aqua,  validam  esse  consecrationem, 
quamvis    omittens    graviter    peccet."      It 
is    impossible    to    see    how    any    person, 
unless    actuated    by    the    "  odium    theo- 
logicum,"  can  object  to  a  custom   plainly 
primitive,  and  simple,  and  symbolically  in- 
structive— ^Bingham,  viii.,  vi.  22 ;  Wheatly, 
p.  284 ;  Bona,  Ber.  Lit.  ii.  c.  9 ;  Neale  and 
Littledale's   Anc.    hit.    p.    120;   Palmer's 
Orig.  Lit.  ii.  77. 

Nevertheless  the  mixed  chalice  has  been 
decided  several  times  by  the  wisdom  of  the 
Privy  Council  to  be  illegal  in  the  Church  of 
England  (See  Cup).     [H.] 

MODUS  DECIMANDI.  This  is  when 
lands,  or  a  yearly  pension,  or  some  money 
or  other  thing,  is  given  to  a  parson  in  lieu 
of  his  tithes.  It  has  become  obsolete 
through  the  Tithe  Commutation  Acts. 

MONARCHIANS  (/ioVor,  &pxr\).  Here- 
tics   in   the    second    century   who   denied 


MONASTERIES 


501 


the  distinction  of  Persons  in  the  Diviae 
Nature.  This  was  one  of  those  evils  which 
arose  from  the  endeavour  to  combine  the 
Egyptian  and  the  Grecian  philosophy  with 
the  Christian  religion.  The  doctrines  of  the 
Trinity,  and  the  Twofold  Nature  of  our 
Lord,  would  naturally  be  the  first  which 
these  philosophers  would  endeavour  to 
explain,  so  that  they  could  be  compre- 
hended by  reason.  Praxeas,  against  whom 
Tertullian  wrote,  but  under  great  personal 
prejudice,  was  the  leader  of  these,  teaching 
that  "  the  whole  Father  of  all  things  joined 
Himself  to  the  Human  nature  of  Christ ; " 
but  he  did  not  erect  a  distinct  Church. 
Theodotus  (who  went  by  the  name  of 
o  o-KUTfuf,  the  tanner),  a  ISyzantine  of  low 
extraction,  but  great  learning,  founded  the 
sect  which  went  by  this  name.  He  was  the 
first  who  asserted  Christ  to  be  mere  man. 
— Euseb.  //.  E.  V.  28;  Stubbs'  Mosheim, 
i.  152.     [H.] 

MONASTERIES.  Convents  or  houses 
Duilt  for  those  who  profess  the  monastic 
life,  whether  abbeys,  priories,  or  nunneries 
(For  the  origin  of  monasteries,  see  Abbey 
and  Monk). 

In  their  first  institution,  and  in  their 
subsequent  uses,  there  can  be  no  doubt  that 
monasteries  were  amongst  the  most  remark- 
able instances  of  Christian  munificence,  and 
they  certainly  were  in  the  dark  ages  among 
the  beneficial  adaptations  of  the  talents  of 
Christians  to  pious  and  charitable  ends. 
They  were  schools  of  education  and  learning, 
where  the  children  of  the  great  received 
their  education;  and  they  were  hospitals 
for  the  poor :  they  afforded  also  a  retirement 
for  the  worn-out  servants  of  the  rich  and 
noble ;  they  protected  the  calmer  spirits, 
who,  in  an  age  of  universal  warfare,  shrank 
from  conflict,  and  desired  to  lead  a  contem- 
plative life.  But  the  evils  which  grew  out  of 
those  societies  seem  in  time  to  have  counter- 
balanced the  good.  Being  often  exempted 
from  the  authority  of  the  bishop,  they 
became  hotbeds  of  ecclesiastical  insubordi- 
nation; and  were  little  else  but  parties  of 
privileged  sectaries  within  the  Church.  The 
temptations  arising  out  of  a  state  of  celibacy, 
too  often  in  the  first  instance  enforced  by 
improper  means,  and  always  bound  upon 
the  members  of  these  societies  by  a  reUgious 
vow,  were  the  occasion  of  great  scandal. 
And  the  enormous  wealth  with  which  some 
of  them  were  endowed,  brought  with  it  a 
greater  degree  of  pride,  and  ostentation,  and 
luxury,  than  was  becoming  in  Christians ; 
and  still  more  in  those  who  had  vowed  a 
life  of  religion  and  asceticism. 

The  dissolution  of  houses  of  this  kind 
begau  so  early  as  the  year  1312,  when  the 
Templars  were  suppressed;  and  in  1323, 
their  lands,  churches,  advovvsons,  and  liber- 


502 


MONASTEEIES 


ties,  here  in  England,  were  given  by  17 
Edward  II.  stat.  iii.  to  the  prior  and  brethren 
of  the  hospital  of  St.  John  of  Jerusalem. 
In  the  years  1390,  1437, 1441, 1459,  1497, 
1505,  1508,  and  1515,  several  other  houses 
were  dissolved,  and  their  revenues  settled 
on  different  colleges  in  Oxford  and  Cam- 
bridge.    Soon  after  the  last  i)eriod,  Cardinal 
Wolsey,  by  licence  of  the  king  and  pope, 
obtained  a  dissolution  of  above  thirty  re- 
ligious  houses  for  founding  and  endovping 
his  colleges  at  Oxford  and  Ipswich.     About 
the  same  time  a  bull  was  granted  by  the 
same  pope  to  Cardinal  Wolsey  to  suppress 
monasteries,  where  there  were  not  above  six 
monks,  to  the  value  of  eight  thousand  ducats 
a  year,  for  endowing  Windsor  and  King's 
College  in  Cambridge ;  and  two  other  bulls 
were  granted  to  Cardinals  Wolsey  and  Cam- 
peius,  where  there  were  less  than  twelve 
monks,    to    annex    them    to    the    greater 
monasteries ;  and  another  bull  to  the  Eame 
cardinals    to  inquire  about  abbeys   to  be 
suppressed  in  order  to  be  made  cathedrals. 
Although    nothing  appears  to   have  been 
done  in   consequence  of   these  bulls,   the 
motive  which  induced  Wolsey  and   many 
others  to  suppress  these  houses,  was  the 
desire  of  promoting   learning;   and  Arch- 
bishop Cranmer  engaged  in  such  suppression 
with  a  view  of  carrying  on  the  Beformation. 
There  were  other  causes  that  concurred  to 
bring  on  their  ruin.    Many  of  the  monks 
were  loose  and  vicious ;  they  were  generally 
thought  to  be  in  their  hearts  attached   to 
the  pope's  supremacy;  their  revenues  were 
not  employed  according  to  the  intent  of  the 
donors ;    many  cheats   in  wonder-working 
images,   feigned    mii-acles,   and  counterfeit 
relics,  had  been  discovered,  which  brought 
the  monks  into  disgrace ;  the  Observant  friars 
had  opposed  the  king's  divorce  from  Queen 
Catharine ;  and  these  circimistances  operated, 
in  concurrence  with  the  king's  want  of  a 
supply,  and  the  people's  desire  to  save  their 
money,  to  forward  a  motion  in  Parliament, 
that,  in  order  to  support  the  king's  state,  and 
supply  his  wants,  all  the  religious  houses 
which  were  not  able  to  spend  above  £200  a 
year,  might  be  conferred  upon  the  Crown ;  and 
an  Act  was  passed  for  that  purpose,  27  Henry 
Vni.  c.  28.     By  this  Act  about  380  houses 
were  dissolved,  and  a  revenue  of  £30,000  or 
£32,000  a  year  came  to  the  Crown ;  besides 
about  £200,000  in  plate  and  jewels.     The 
suppression  of  these  houses  occasioned  dis- 
content, and  at  length  an  open  rebellion : 
when  this  was  appeased,  the  king  resolved 
to  suppress  the  rest  of  the  monasteries,  and 
appointed  a  new  visitation,  which  caused 
the  greater  abbeys  to  be  surrendered  apace ; 
and  it  was  enacted  by  31  Henry  VIII.  c.  13, 
that  all  monasteries  which  had  been  surren- 
dered since  the  4th  of  February,  in  the 


MONASTEEIES 

twenty-seventh  year  of  his  Majesty's  reign, 
and  which  thereafter  should  be  surrendered, 
should  be  vested  in  the  king.  The  Knights 
of  St.  John  of  Jerusalem  were  also  sup- 
pressed by  the  32nd  Henry  VIII.  c.  24. 
The  suppression  of  these  greater  houses  by 
these  two  Acts  produced  a  revenue  to  the 
king  of  above  £100,000  a  year,  besides  a 
large  sum  in  plate  and  jewels.  The  last  Act 
of  dissolution  in  this  king's  reign  was  the 
Act  of  37  Henry  VIII.  c.  4,  for  dissolving 
colleges,  free  chapels,  chantries,  &c.,  which, 
Act  was  further  enforced  by  1  Edward  VI. 
c.  14.  By  this  Act  were  suppressed  90' 
colleges,  110  hospitals,  and  2374  chantries 
and  free  chapels. 

Whatever  were  the  offences  of  the  race  of 
men  then  inhabiting  them,  this  destruction 
of  the  monasteries  was  nothing  less  than 
sacrilege,  and  can  on  no  ground  be  justified. 
They  were  the  property  of  the  Church ;  and 
if,  while  the  Church  cast  off  divers  errors  in 
doctrine  which  she  had  too  long  endured^ 
she  had  been  permitted  to  purge  these  in- 
stitutions of  some  practical  errors,  and  of 
certain  flagrant  vices,  they  might  have  been 
exceedingly  serviceable  to  the  cause  of  re- 
ligion. Cranmer  felt  this  very  forcibly,  and 
begged  earnestly  of  Henry  VIII.  that  he 
would  save  some  of  the  monasteries  for  holy 
and  religious  uses ;  but  in  vain.  Ridley  also 
was  equally  anxious  for  their  preservation. 
It  is  a  mistake  to  suppose  that  the  monas- 
teries were  erected  and  endowed  by  Papists. 
Many  of  them  were  endowed  before  most  of 
the  errors  of  the  Papists  were  thought  of: 
and  the  founders-  of  abbeys  afterwards  built 
and  endowed  them,  not  as  Papists,  but  as- 
churchmen ;  and  when  the  Church  became 
pure,  she  did  not  lose  any  portion  of  her 
right  to  such  endowments  as  were  always 
made  in  supposition  of  her  purity  (See 
Num.  xviii.  32;  Lev.  xxv.  23,  24;  Ezek. 
xlviii.  14). 

Although  much  ot  the  confiscated  pro- 
perty was  profligately  squandered  and  con- 
sumed by  the  Eussells,  the  Cavendishes,  &c., 
still,  out  of  the  receipts,  Henry  VIII.  founded 
six  new  bishoprics,  viz.  those  of  Westminster 
(which  was  changed  by  Queen  Elizabeth 
into  a  deanery,  with  twelve  prebends  and  a 
school),  Peterborough,  Chester,  Gloucester, 
Bristol,  and  Oxford.  And  in  eight  other 
sees  he  founded  deaneries  and  chapters,  by 
converting  the  priors  and  monks  into  deans 
and  prebendaries,  viz.  Canterbury,  Win- 
chester, Durham,  Worcester,  Eochester, 
Norwich,  Ely,  and  Carlisle.  He  founded 
also  the  house  of  Christ  Church  in  Oxford, 
refounded  Trinity  Cbllege  in  Cambridge  on  a 
grander  scale,  and  completed  King's  College. 
He  likewise  founded  professorships  of 
divinity,,  law,  physic,  and  of  the  Hebrew: 
and  Geeek  tongues  in  both  the  said  uni- 


MONASTERY 

versities.  He  gave  the  house  of  Greyfriars 
and  St.  Bartholomew's  Hospital  to  the  city 
of  London,  and  a  perpetual  pension  to 
the  poor  Knights  of  Windsor,  and  laid  out 
great  sums  in  building  and  fortifying  many 
ports  in  the  Channel.  It  is  observable 
that  the  dissolution  of  these  houses  was  an 
act,  not  of  the  Church,  but  of  the  State,  prior 
to  any  reformation  of  doctrine  or  ritual,  by  a 
king  and  parliament  of  the  Roman  Catholic 
communion  in  all  points  except  the  king's 
supremacy ;  to  which  the  pope  himself,  by 
his  bulls  and  licences,  had  led  the  way. — 
Burnet's  Hist.  Eeform.  i.  367  seq. ;  Hallam's 
Mid.  Ages,  iii.  292 ;  Wright's  Suppres. 
Monast. ;  Hook's  Archbishops,  ii.  20 :  iii. 
43,  205  :  vi.  69,  76,  114  :  vii.  37. 

Of  the  monasteries  which  had  been 
attached  to  cathedrals  before  the  Reforma- 
tion, the  heads  were  called  Priors  (which 
answered  to  dean),  never  Abbots ;  as  the 
bishop  was  considered  as  virtually  the  abbot. 
The  Bishop  of  Ely  actually  occupied,  as  he 
still  does,  the  abbot's  place  in  the  choir  (i.e. 
the  stall  usually  assigned  to  the  dean),  as 
the  bishop  has  done  since  the  Reformation 
at  Carlisle,  though  in  the  latter  place  he  had 
a  throne  also.  Christ  Church  monastery  in 
Dublin,  which  had  always  been  a  cathedral 
chapter,  was  also  secularized  at  the  Re- 
formation. 

MONASTERY.  In  architectural  arrange- 
ment, monastic  establishments,  whether 
abbeys,  priories,  or  other  convents,  followed 
nearly  the  same  plan. 

The  great  enclosure  (varying,  of  course, 
in  extent  with  the  wealth  and  importance 
of  the  monastery),  and  generally  with  a 
stream  running  beside  it,  was  surrounded 
by  a  wall,  the  principal  entrance  being 
through  a  gateway  to  the  west  or  north- 
west. This  gateway  was  a  considerable 
building,  and  often  contained  a  chapel,  with 
its  altar,  besides  the  necessary  accommo- 
dation for  the  porter.  The  almery,  or  place 
where  alms  were  distributed,  stood  not  far 
vrithin  the  great  gate,  and  generally  a  little 
to  the  right  hand :  there,  too,  was  often  a 
chapel  with  its  altar.  Proceeding  onwards 
the  west  entrance  of  the  church  appeared. 
TTie  church  itself  was  always,  where  it  re- 
ceived its  due  development,  in  the  form  of  a 
Latin  cross ;  a  cross,  i.e.  of  which  the  tran- 
septs are  short  in  proportion  to  the  nave. 
Moreover,  in  Norman  churches,  the  eastern 
limb  never  approached  the  nave  or  western 
limb  in  length.  Whether  or  no  the  reason  of 
this  preference  of  the  Latin  cross  is  found  in 
the  domestic  arrangements  of  the  monastic 
buildings,  it  was  certainly  best  adapted  to 
it ;  for  the  nave  of  the  church  with  one  of 
the  transepts  formed  the  whole  of  one  side 
and  part  of  another  side  of  a  quadrangle  ; 
and  any  other  than  a  long  nave  would  have 


MONASTERY 


503 


involved  a  small  quadrangle,  while  a  long 
transept  would  leave  too  little  of  another 
side,  or  none  at  all,  for  other  buildings. 
How  the  internal  arrangements  were  afifected 
by  this  adaptation  of  the  nave  to  external 
requirements,  we  have  seen  under  the  head 
Cathedral,  to  which  also  we  refer  for  the 
general  description  of  the  conventual 
church. 

Southward  of  the  chiu'ch,  and  parallel 
with  the  south  transept,  was  carried  the 
western  range  of  the  monastic  offices ;  but  it 
will  be  more  convenient  to  examine  their 
arrangement  within  the  court.  We  enter 
then  by  a  door  near  the  west  end  of  the 
church,  and  passing  through  a  vaulted 
passage,  find  ourselves  in  the  cloister  court, 
of  which  the  nave  of  the  church  forms  the 
northern  side,  the  transept  part  of  the 
eastern  side  and  other  buildings,  in  the 
order  to  be  presently  described,  complete 
the  quadrangle.  The  cloisters  themselves 
extended  around  the  whole  of  the  quad- 
rangle, serving,  among  other  purposes,  as  a 
covered  way  from  every  part  of  the  convent 
to  every  other  part.  They  were  furnished, 
perhaps  always,  with  lavatories,  on  the 
decoration  and  construction  of  which  much 
cost  was  expended;  and  sometimes  also 
vrith  desks  and  closets  of  wainscot,  which 
served  the  purpose  of  a  scriptorium. 

Commencing  the  circuit  of  the  cloisters 
at  the  north-west  comer,  and  turning 
southward,  we  have  the  Chapter  House,  for 
meetings  of  the  members,  then  the  dormi- 
tory, or  dorter,  the  use  of  which  is  sufficiently 
indicated  by  its  name.  This  occupied  the 
whole  of  the  western  side  of  the  quadrangle, 
and  had  sometimes  a  groined  passage  beneath 
its  whole  length,  called  the  ambulatory,  a 
noble  example  of  which,  in  perfect  pre- 
servation, remains  at  Fountains,  of  which 
a  plan  is  given  on  next  page. 

The  south  side  of  the  quadrangle  contained 
the  refectory,  with  its  correlative,  the  coquina 
or  kitchen,  which  was  sometimes  at  its  side, 
and  sometimes  behind  it.  The  refectory 
was  furnished  with  a  pulpit,  for  the  reading 
of  some  portion  of  Scripture  during  meals. 
On  this  side  of  the  quadrangle  may  also  be 
found,  in  general,  the  locutorium,  or  parlour, 
the  latter  word  being,  at  least  in  etymology, 
the  full  equivalent  of  the  former.  The 
abbots  lodge  commonly  commenced  at  the 
south-east  comer  of  the  quadrangle ;  but, 
instead  of  conforming  itself  to  its  general 
direction,  rather  extended  eastward,  with  its 
own  chapel,  hall,  parlour,  kitchen,  and  other 
offices,  in  a  hne  parallel  with  the  choir  ov 
eastem  limb  of  the  church.  Turning  north- 
wards, still  continuing  within  the  cloisters, 
we  come  first  to  an  open  passage  leading 
outwards,  then  to  the  chapter-house,  or  its 
vestibule ;  then,  after  another  open  passage. 


^  M  i:  - 

o"  0^  frS  frl 


MONITION 

to  the  south  transept  of  the  church.  Imme- 
diately before  us  is  an  entrance  into  the 
church,  and  another  occurs  at  the  end  of 
the  west  cloister. 

The  parts  of  the  establishment  especially 
connected  with  sewerage  were  built  over  or 
close  to  the  stream;  and  we  may  remark 
that,  both  in  drainage  and  in  the  supply  of 
water,  great  and  laudable  care  was  always 
taken. 

The  stream  also  turned  the  abhey  mill, 
at  a  small  distance  from  the  monastery. 
Other  offices,  such  as  stables,  hrew-houses, 
hake-houses,  and  the  like,  in  the  larger 
estabUshments,  usually  occupied  another 
court ;  and  in  the  smaller,  were  connected 
TOth  the  chief  buildings  in  the  only  quad- 
rangle. It  is  needless  to  say  that,  in  so 
general  an  account,  we  cannot  enumerate 
exceptional  cases.  It  may,  however,  be 
necessary  to  say,  that  the  greatest  difference 
of  all,  that  of  placing  the  quadrangle  at  the 
north  instead  of  the  south  side  of  th^ 
church,  is  not  unknown ;  it  is  so  at  Canter- 
bury and  at  Lincoln,  for  instance. 

The  subject  may  be  followed  out  in  the 
several  plans  of  monasteries  scattered  among 
our  topographical  works,  and  in  a  paper 
read  by  Mr.  Bloxam  before  the  Bedfordshire 
Architectural  Society,  and  published  in  their 
Report  for  1850,  and  Mackenzie  Walcott's 
GonventmiL  Arrangement,  and  his  Minsters 
and  Abbeys. 

MONITION.  An  order  from  an  eccle- 
siastical court  to  do  or  abstain  from  doing 
something.  Monitions  are  of  two  kinds  : 
one  is  a  monition  only,  as  to  a  lay  rector  to 
repair  his  chancel,  or  to  either  a  clergyman 
or  layman  to  remove  ornaments  which  he 
has  introduced  illegally,  or  to  stop  making 
alterations  not  authorised  by  a  faculty,  and 
if  necessary,  to  restore  the  former  condition 
of  the  church.  The  other  is  the  monition 
which  it  has  for  ages  been  the  practice  to 
append  to  a  "  definitive  sentence  "  condemn- 
ing a  clergyman  for  illegal  practices,  not  to 
do  so  any  more.  In  one  of  the  many 
phases  of  the  Mackonochie  case  L.  C.  J. 
Cockbum  and  one  other  judge  held  that  the 
Dean  of  Arches  had  no  jurisdiction  to  punish 
for  disobeying  such  a  monition,  but  both 
the  Court  of  Appeal  and  the  House  of  Lords 
held  that  he  had,  without  instituting  a 
fresh  suit  ai  initio.  Monitions  may  be  en- 
forced either  by  suspension  or  by  "  signifying" 
for  contempt  in  the  case  of  a  layman,  which 
means  imprisonment.  Nor  is  the  old  juris- 
diction of  the  ecclesiastical  courts  taken  away 
to  monish  laymen  against  living  in  adultery 
or  incest,  which  a  late  dean  of  arches  said 
might  be  followed  by  excommunication, 
which  again  may  be  imprisonment  for  six 
months  (See  Excommvnication).   [G.] 

MONKS.   The  word  monk,  being  derived 


MONKS 


505 


from  the  Greek  /idi/or,  solus,  signifies  the 
same  as  a  solitary,  or  one  who  lives  se- 
questered from  tbe  company  and  con- 
versation of  the  rest  of  the  world,  and  is 
usually  applied  to  those  who  dedicate  them- 
selves wholly  to  the  service  of  religion,  in 
some  monastery  (as  it  is  called)  or  religious 
house,  and  under  the  direction  of  some 
particular  statutes,  or  rule.  Those  of  the 
female  sex  who  devote  themselves  in  like 
manner  to  a  religious  life,  are  called  nuns 
(See  Nwns). 

There  is  some  difference  in  the  sentiments 
of  learned  men  concerning  the  origin  and 
rise  of  the  monastic  life.  But  the  most 
probable  account  of  this  matter  seems  to  be 
as  follows : 

Till  the  year  250,  there  were  no  monks, 
but  only  ascetics,  in  the  Church  (See 
Ascetics'). 

In  the  Decian  persecution,  which  was 
about  the  middle  of  the  third  century, 
many  persons  in  Egypt,  to  avoid  the  fury 
of  the  stonn,  fled  to  the  neighbouring 
deserts  and  mountaius,  where  they  not  only 
found  a  safe  retreat,  but  also  more  time  and 
liberty  to  exercise  themselves  in  acts  of 
piety  and  Divine  contemplations ;  which 
sort  of  life  became  so  agreeable  to  them, 
that  when  the  persecution  was  over,  they 
refused  to  return  to  their  habitations  again, 
choosing  rather  to  continue  in  those  cottages 
and  cells  which  they  had  made  for  them- 
selves in  the  wilderness. 

The  first  and  most  noted  of  these  soli- 
taries were  Paul  and  Anthony,  two  famous 
Egyptians,  whom  therefoie  St.  Jerome  calls 
the  fathers  of  the  Christian  hermits.  Some 
indeed  carry  up  the  original  of  the  monastic 
life  as  high  as  St.  I  John  Baptist  and  Elias. 
But  learned  men  generally  reckon  Paul  the 
Thebajan,  and  Anthony,  as  the  first  pro- 
moters of  this  way  of  living  among  the 
Christians. 

As  yet  there  were  no  bodies  or  commu- 
nities of  men  embracing  this  life,  nor  any 
monasteries  built,  but  only  a  few  single 
persons  scattered  here  and  there  in  the 
deserts  of  Egypt,  till  Pachomius,  in  the 
peaceable  reign  of  Constantme,  procured 
some  monasteries  to  be  built  in  Thebais  in 
Egypt,  from  whence  the  custom  of  living  in 
societies  was  followed  by  degrees  in  other 
parts  of  the  world,  and  in  succeeding  ages. 

Macarius  peopled  the  Egyptian  desert  of 
Scetis  with  monks.  Hilarion,  a  disciple  of 
Anthony's,  was  the  first  monk  in  Palestine 
or  Syria.  Not  long  after,  Eustathius, 
bishop  of  Sebaste,  brought  monachism  into 
Armenia,  Paphlagonia,  and  Pontus.  But 
St.  Basil  is  generally  cohsidered  as  the  great 
father  and  patriarch  of  the  Eastern  monks. 
It  was  he  who  reduced  the  monastic  life  to 
a  fixed  state  of  uniformity,  who  united  the 


50G 


MONKS 


Anchorets  and  Coenobites,  and  obliged  them 
to  engage  themselves  by  solemn  vows.  It 
was  St.  Basil  who  prescribed  rules  for  the 
government  and  direction  of  the  monasteries, 
to  which  rules  most  of  the  disciples  of 
Anthony,  Pachomius,  and  Macarius,  and 
the  other  ancient  fathers  of  the  deserts, 
submitted.  And  to  this  day,  all  the  Greeks, 
Nestorians,  Melchites,  Georgians,  Min- 
grelians,  and  Armenians,  follow  the  rule  of 
St.  Basil. 

The  monastic  profession  made  no  less 
progress  in  the  West.  Athanasius,  bishop 
of  Alexandria,  retiring  to  Eome,  about  the 
year  339,  with  several  priests,  and  two 
Egyptian  monks,  made  known  to  several 
pious  persons  the  life  of  Anthony,  who  then 
lived  in  the  desert  of  Thebais  ;  upon  which 
many  were  desirous  to  embrace  so  holy  a 
profession.  To  this  effect  several  monas- 
teries were  built  at  Eome,  and  this  example 
was  soon  followed  all  over  Italy.  Benedict 
of  Nursia  appeared  in  that  country  in  the 
early  part  of  the  sixth  century,  and  pub- 
lished his  rule,  which  was  universally 
received  throughout  the  West ;  for  which 
reason  that  saint  was  styled  the  patriarch  of 
the  Western  monks,  as  St.  Basil  was  of  the 
Eastern. 

France  owes  the  institution  of  the  mon- 
astic hfe  to  St.  Martin,  bishop  of  Tours, 
in  the  fourth  century ;  who  built  the  mon- 
asteries of  Lugug^  and  Marmoutier.  The 
Council  of  Saragossa,  in  Spain,  a.d.  380, 
which  condemns  the  practice  of  priests, 
who  affected  to  wear  the  monastical  habits, 
is  a  proof  that  there  were  monks  in  that 
kingdom  in  the  fourth  century,  before  St. 
Donatus  went  thither  out  of  Africa,-  with 
seventy  disciples,  and  founded  the  monastery 
of  Sirbita. 

Augustine,  being  sent  into  England  by 
Gregory  the  Great,  in  the  year  596,  to 
preach  the  faith,  at  the  same  time  intro- 
duced the  monastic  state  into  this  kingdom. 
It  made  so  great  a  progress  here, '  that, 
within  the  space  of  200  years,  there  were 
thirty  kings  and  queens  who  preferred  the 
religious  habit  to  their  crowns,  and  founded 
stately  monasteries,  where  they  ended  their 
days  in  retirement  and  solitude. 

The  monastic  profession  was  also  carried 
into  Ireland  by  St.  Patrick,  who  is  looked 
upon  as  the  apostle  of  that  island. 

The  monastic  life  soon  made  very  great 
progress  all  over  the  Christian  world. 
Eufinus,  who  travelled  through  the  East  in 
373,  assures  us  there  were  almost  as  many 
monks  in  the  deserts  as  inhabitants  in  the 
cities.  From  the  wUdemess  (contrary  to 
its  original  institution)  it  maide  its  way 
into  the  towns  and  cities,  where  it  multi- 
plied greatly :  for  the  same  author  informs 
us,  that,  in  the   single  city  of   Oxirinca, 


MONKS 

there  were  more  monasteries  than  private 
houses,  and  above  30,000  monks. 

The  ancient  monks  were  not,  like  the 
modern,  distinguished  into  orders,  and  de- 
nominated from  the  founders  of  them ;  but 
they  had  their  names  from  the  places  where 
they  inhabited,  as  the  monks  of  Scetis, 
Tabennesus,  Nitria,  Canopus  in  Egypt,  &c., 
or  else  were  distinguished  by  their  different 
ways  of  living.  Of  these  the  most  re- 
markable were  : 

1.  The  anchorets,  so  called  from  their 
retiring  from  society,  and  living  in  private 
cells  in  the  wilderness  (See  Anchorets). 

2.  The  Coenobites,  so  denominated  from 
their    living    together    in    common    (See 

All  monks  were,  originally,  no  more  than 
laymen :  nor  could  they  well  be  otherwise, 
being  confined  by  their  own  rules  to  some 
desert  or  wilderness  where  there  could  be 
no  room  for  the  exercise  of  the  clerical 
functions.  Accordingly  St.  Jerome  tells 
us,  the  office  of  a  monk  is,  not  to  teach,  but 
to  mourn.  The  Council  of  Chalcedon  ex- 
pressly distinguishes  the  monks  from  the 
clergy,  and  reckons  them  with  the  laymen. 
Gratian  himself,  who  is  most  interested  for 
the  modems,  owns  it  to  be  plain  from  eccle- 
siastical history,  that  to  the  time  of  Pope 
Siricius  and  Zosimus,  the  monks  were  only 
monks,  and  not  clerics. 

In  some  cases,  however,  the  clerical  and 
monastic  life  were  capable  of  being  con- 
joined; as,  first,  when  a  monastery  hap- 
pened to  be  at  so  great  a  distance  from  its 
proper  church,  that  the  monks  could  not 
ordinarily  resort  thither  for  Divine  service, 
which  was  the  case  of  the  monasteries  in 
Egypt  and  other  parts  of  the  East.  In 
this  case,  some  one  or  more  of  the  monks 
were  ordained  for  the  performance  of  Di- 
vine offices  among  them.  Another  case,  in 
which  the  clerical  and  monastic  life  were 
imited,  was,  when  monks  were  taken  out  of 
monasteries  by  the  bishops,  and  ordained 
for  the  service  of  the  Church.  This  was 
allowed,  and  encouraged,  when  once  mon- 
asteries were  become  schools  of  learning 
and  pious  education.  In  this  case  they 
usually  continued  their  ancient  austerities  • 
and  upon  this  account  the  Greeks  styled 
them  Upofiovaxo'i,  clergy-monks.  Thirdly, 
it  happened  sometimes  that  a  bishop  and 
all  his  clergy  embraced  the  monastic  life 
by  a  voluntary  renunciation  of  property, 
and  enjoyed  all  things  in  common.  Buse- 
bius  Vercellensis  was  the  first  who  brought 
in  this  way  of  Kving,  and  St.  Augustin 
lived  thus  among  the  clergy  of  Hippo. 
And  so  far  as  this  was  an  imitation  of 
ccenobitic  life,  and  having  all  things  in 
common,  it  might  be  called  a  monastic  as 
well  as  a  clerical  life. 


MONKS 

The  CajDobites,  or  suck  monks  as  lived  in 
communities,  were  chiefly  regarded  by  the 
Church,  and  were  therefore,  during  the  first 
six  centuries  under  the  Empire,  subjected  to 
certain  laws  and  rules  of  government,  of 
which  we  shall  here  give  a  short  account. 

1.  All  men  were  not  allowed  to  turn 
monks  at  pleasure,  because    such    an   in- 

^  discriminate  permission  would  have  been 
detrimental  both  to  the  Church  and  State. 
Upon  this  account  the  civil  law  forbade 
any  of  those  ofiicers  called  curiales  to 
become  monks,  unless  they  parted  with 
their  estates  to  others,  who  might  serve 
their"  country  in  their  stead.  For  the 
same  reason  servants  were  not  to  be  ad- 
mitted into  any  monastery  without  their 
masters'  leave.  Indeed,  Justinian  after- 
wards abrogated  this  law  by  an  edict  of 
his  own,  which  first  set  servants  at  liberty 
from  their  masters,  under  pretence  of  be- 
taking themselves  to  a  monastic  life.  The 
same  precautions  were  observed  in  regard 
to  married  persons  and  children.  The 
former  were  not  to  embrace  the  monastic 
life,  tmless  with  the  mutual  consent  of  both 
parties.  This  precaution  was  afterwards 
broken  through  by  Justinian;  but  the 
Church  never  approved  of  this  innovation. 
As  to  children,  the  Council  of  Gangra 
decreed  that  if  any  such,  under  pretence  of 
religion,  forsook  their  parents,  they  should 
be  anathematized.  But  Justinian  enervated 
the  force  of  this  law  likewise,  forbidding 
parents  to  hinder  their  children  from  be- 
coming monks  or  clerks.  And  as  children 
were  not  to  turn  monks  without  consent 
of  their  parents,  so  neither  could  parents 
oblige  their  children  to  embrace  a  monastic 
life  against  their  own  consent.  But  the 
fourth  Council  of  Toledo,  a.d.  633,  set  aside 
this  precaution,  and  decreed  that,  whether 
the  devotion  of  their  parents,  or  their  own 
profession,  made  them  monks,  both  should 
be  equally  binding,  and  there  should  be  no 
permission  to  return  to  a  secular  life  again, 
as  was  before  allowable,  when  a  parent 
offered  a  child  before  he  was  capable  of 
giving  his  own  consent. 

2.  The  manner  of  admission  to  the  monastic 
life  was  usually  by  some  change  of  habit 
or  dress,  not  to  signify  any  religious  mys- 
tery, but  only  to  express  their  gravity  and 
contempt  of  the  world..  Long  hair  was 
always  thought  an  indecency  in  men,  and 
savouring  of  secular  vanity ;  and  therefore 
they  polled  every  monk  at  his  admission,  to 
distinguish  him  from  seculars ;  but  they 
never  shaved  any,  for  fear  they  should  look 
too  like  the  priests  of  Isis.  This,  there- 
fore, was  the  ancient  tonsure,  in  opposition 
to  both  these  extremes.  As  to  their  habit 
and  clothing,  the  rule  was  the  same :  they 
were  to  be  decent  and  grave,  as  became  their 


MONKS 


5017 


profession.  The  monks  of  Tabennesus,  in 
Thebais,  seem  to  have  been  the  only  monks 
in  those  early  days  who  were  confined  to 
any  particular  habit.  St.  Jerome,  who  often 
speaks  of  the  habit  of  the  monks,  intimates 
that  it  differed  from  others  only  in  this,  that 
it  was  a  cheaper,  coarter,  and  meaner 
raiment,  expressing  their  humility  and  con- 
tempt of  the  w.orld,  without  any  singularity 
or  affectation.  The  father  is  very  severe 
against  the  practice  of  some  who  appeared 
in  chains  or  sackcloth.  And  Cassian  blames 
others  who  carried  wooden  crosses  con- 
tinually about  their  necks,  which  was  only 
proper  to  excite  the  laughter  of  the  spec- 
tators. In  short,  tho  Western  monks  used 
only  a  common  habit,  the  philosophic 
pallium,  as  many  other  Christians  did. 
And  Salvian  seems  to  give  an  exact  de- 
scription of  the  habit  and  tonsure  of  the 
monks,  when,  reflecting  on  the  Africans  for 
their  treatment  of  them,  he  says,  "they 
oould  scarce  ever  see  a  man  with  short  hair, 
a  pale  face,  and  habited  in  a  pallium,  with- 
out reviling,  and  bestowing  some  reproachful 
language  on  him."  > 

We  read  of  no  solemn  vow,  or  profession,  1 
required  at  their  admission:  but  they 
underwent  a  triennial  probation,  during 
which  time  they  were  inured  to  the  exer- 
cises of  the  monastic  life.  If,  after  that 
time  was  expired,  they  chose  to  continue 
the  same  exercises,  they  were  then  admitted 
without  any  further  ceremony  into  the  com- 
munity. '  This  was  the  method  prescribed 
by  Pachomius,  the  father  of  the  monks  of 
Tabennesus,  from  which  all  others  took 
their  model. 

Nor  was  there,  as  yet,  any  solemn  vow  of 
poverty  required ;  though  it  was  customary 
for  men  voluntarily  to  renounce  the  world  by 
disposing  of  their  estates  to  charitable  uses, 
before  they  entered  into  a  community,  where 
they  were  to  enjoy  all  things  in  common. 
Nor  did  they,  after  renouncing  their  own 
estates,  seek  to  enrich  themselves,  or  their 
monasteries,  by  begging,  or  accepting,  the 
estates  of  others.  The  Western  monks  did 
not  always  adhere  to  this  rule,  as  appears 
from  some  imperial  laws  made  to  restrain 
their  avarice.  But  the  monks  of  Kgypt 
were  generally  just  in  their  pretensions,  and 
would  accept  of  no  donations  but  for  the  use 
of  the  poor.  Some,  indeed,  did  not  wholly 
renounce  all  property,  but  kept  their  estates 
in  their  own  hands,  the  whole  yearly 
revenue  of  which  they  distributed  in  chari- 
table uses. 

As    the   monasteries    had    no    standing  | 
revenues,   all  the   monks  were  obhged   to  ' 
exercise    themselves    in    bodily  labour    to 
maintain  themselves,  without  being  burden- 
some to  others.     They  had  no  idle  mendi- 
cants  among  them:   they  looked  upon  a 


508 


MONKS 


monk  that  did  not  work  as  no  better  than 
a  covetous  defrauder.  Sozomen  tells  us 
i(lib.  vi.  c.  28)  that  Serapion  presided  over 
a  monastery  of  ten  thousand  monks,  near 
Arsinoij  in  Egypt,  who  all  laboured  with 
their  own  hands,  by  which  means  they 
not  only  maintained  themselves,  but  had 
enough  to  relieve  the  poor. 

The  monasteries  were  commonly  divided 
into  several  parts,  and  proper  officers  ap- 
pointed over  each  of  them.  Every  ten 
monks  were  subject  to  one,  who  was  called 
the  decanus,  or  dean,  from  his  presiding 
over  ten ;  and  eveiy  hundred  had  another 
officer  called  centenarius,  from  his  presiding 
over  a  hundred.  Above  these  were  the 
patres,  or  fathers  of  the  monasteries,  called 
likewise  abbates,  ahhots,  from  the  Greek 
^(3i3as,  which  signifies  father ;  and  Jiegu- 
mieni  (tyyovfuvoi)  presidents ;  and  archi- 
mandrites, from  mandra,  a  sheep-fold.  The 
"business  of  the  deans  was  to  exact  every 
man's  daily  task,  and  bring  it  to  the  ceco- 
nomus,  or  steward,  who  gave  a  monthly 
account  thereof   to    the    father,   or  abbot 

^  <See  Jhbot). 

.  To  their  bodily  exercises  they  joined 
■others  that  were  spiritual.  The  first  of 
these  was  a  perpetual  repentance.  Upon 
which  account  the  life  of  a  monk  is  often 
styled  the  life  of  a  mourner  (St.  Jerome, 
Ep.  hii.  ad  Sipar.).  And  in  allusion  to  this, 
the  isle  of  Canopus,  near  Alexandria,  for- 
merly a  place  of  great  lewdness,  was,  upon 
the  translation  and  settlement  of  the  monks 
of  Tabennesus  there,  called  Insulse  Metanoex, 
'  the  Isle  of  Repentance. 

The  next  spiritual  exercise  was   extra- 

■'  ordinary  fasting.  The  Egyptian  monks 
kept  every  day  a  fast  till  three  in  the 
afternoon,  excepting  Saturdays,  Sundays, 
and  the  fifty  days  of  Pentecost.  Some 
exercised  themselves  with  very  great  aus- 
terities, fasting  two,  three,  four,  or  five  days 
together ;  but  this  practice  was  not  generally 
approved.  Men  did  not  think  such  ex- 
cessive abstinence  of  any  use,  but  rather  a 
■dis-service  to  reUgion.  Pachomius's  rule, 
which  was  said  to  be  given  him  by  an 
angel,  permitted  every  man  to  eat,  drink, 
and  labour,  according  to  his  bodily  strength. 
So  that  fasting  was  a  discretionary  thing, 
and  matter  of  choice,  not  of  compulsion. 

Their  fastings  were  accompanied  with 
extraordinary  and  frequent  returns  of  de- 
motion. The  monks  of  Palestine,  Meso- 
potamia, and  other  parts  of  the  East,  had 
six  or  seven  canonical  hours  of  prayer. 
Besides  which  they  had  their  constant 
vigils  or  nocturnal  meetings.  The  monks 
of  Egypt  met  only  twice  a  day  for  public 
devotion ;  but,  in  their  private  cells,  whilst 
they  were  at  work,  they  were  always  re- 
peating psalms  and  other  parts  of  Scrip- 


MONKS 

ture,  and  intermixing  prayers  with  their 
bodily  labour.  St.  Jerome's  description  of 
their  devotion  is  very  lively  (JEp.  xxii.  ad 
Eustath.  c.  15).  "  When  they  are  assembled 
together  (says  that  father),  at  nine  o'clock 
psalms  are  sung,  and  the  Scriptures  read  : 
then,  prayers  being  ended,  they  all  sit 
down,  and  the  father  begins  a  discourse 
to  them,  which  they  hear  with  the  pro- 
foundest  silence  and  veneration.  His  words 
make  a  deep  impression  on  them ;  their  eyes 
overflow  with  tears,  and  the  speaker's  com- 
mendation is  the  weeping  of  his  hearers. 
Yet  no  one's  grief  expresses  itself  in  an 
indecent  strain.  But  when  he  comes  to 
speak  of  the  kingdom  of  heaven,  of  future 
happiness,  and  the  glory  of  the  world  to 
come,  then  one  may  observe  each  of  them, 
with  a  gentle  sigh,  and  eyes  lifted  up  to 
heaven,  say  within  himself,  '  Oh  that  I  had 
the  wings  of  a  dove,  for  then  would  I  flee 
away,  and  be  at  rest ! '"  In  some  places, 
they  had  the  Scriptures  read  during  their 
meals  at  table.  This  custom  was  first  re- 
sorted to  in  the  monasteries  of  Cappadocia, 
to  prevent  idle  discourses  and  contentions. 
But  in  Egypt  they  had  no  occasion  for  this 
remedy ;  for  they  were  taught  to  eat  their 
meat  in  silence.  Palladius  {Hist.  Lausi.  c. 
lii.)  mentions  one  instance  more  of  their 
devotion,  which  was  only  occasional ;  namely, 
their  psalmody  at  the  reception  of  any 
brethren,  or  the  conducting  them  with  sing- 
ing of  psalms  to  their  habitation. 

The  laws  did  not  allow  monks  to  interest 
themselves  in  any  public  affairs,  either 
ecclesiastical  or  civil ;  and  those  who  were 
called  to  any  employment  in  the  Church 
were  obliged  to  quit  their  monastery  there- 
upon. Nor  were  they  permitted  to  en- 
croach upon  the  duties,  or  rights  and  pri- 
vileges, of  the  secular  clergy. 

By  the  laws  of  their  first  institution,  in 
all  iiarts  of  the  East,  their  habitation  was 
not  to  be  in  cities,  or  places  of  public  con- 
course, but  in  deserts  and  private  retire- 
ments, as  their  very  name  implied.  The 
famous  monk  Anthony  used  to  say,  "  That 
the  wilderness  was  as  natural  to  a  monk, 
as  water  to  a  fish ;  and  therefore  a  monk 
in  a  city  was  quite  out  of  his  element,  like 
a  fish  upon  dry  land."  Theodosius  enacted, 
that  all  who  made  profession  of  the  monastic 
life  should  be  obliged  by  the  civil  magistrate 
to  betake  themselves  to  the  wilderness,  as 
their  proper  habitation.  Baronius,  by  mis-  , 
take,  reckons  this  law  a  punishment,  andu 
next  to  a  persecution  of  the  monks.  Jus- 
tinian made  laws  to  the  same  purpose, 
forbidding  the  Eastern  monks  to  appear 
in  cities ;  but,  if  they  had  any  business 
of  concern  to  be  transacted  there,  they 
might  do  it  by  their  Apocrisarii  or  Be- 
sponscdes,  that  is,  their  proctors  or  syndics, 


MONOGKAM 

which  every  monastery  was  allowed  for  that 
purpose. 

But  this  rule  admitted  of  some  excep- 
tions. As,  first,  in  times  of  common  danger 
to  the  faith.  Thus  Anthony  came  to  Alex- 
andria, at  the  request  of  Athanasius,  to 
confute  the  Arian  heresy.  Sometimes  they 
thought  it  necessary  to  come  and  intercede 
with  the  emperors  and  judges  for  con- 
demned criminals.  Thus  the  monks  in  the 
neighbourhood  of  Antioch  forsook  their 
cells,  to  intercede  with  the  emjjeror  Theo- 
dosius,  who  was  highly  displeased  with 
that  city  for  demolishing  the  imperial 
statues.  Afterwards,  indeed,  this  practice 
grew  into  an  abuse,  and  the  monks  were 
not  contented  to  petition,  but  would  some- 
times come  in  great  bodies  or  troops,  and 
deliver  criminals  by  force.  To  repress  which 
tumultuous  way  of  proceeding,  Arcadius 
published  a  law,  forbidding  any  such  at- 
tempts under  very  severe  jienalties. 

As  the  monks  of  the  ancient  Church 
were  under  no  solemn  vow  or  profession, 
they  were  at  liberty  to  betake  themselves 
to  a  secular  life  again.  Julian  himself  was 
once  in  the  monastic  habit.  The  same  is 
observed  of  Constans,  the  son  of  that  Con- 
stantine,  who,  in  the  reign  of  Honorius, 
usurped  the  empire  in  Britain.  The  rule 
of  Pachomius,  by  which  the  Egyptian  monks 
were  governed,  has  no  mention  of  .any  vow 
at  their  entrance,  nor  any  punishment  for 
such  as  deserted  their  station  aftenvards. 

In  process  oi  time,  it  was  thought  proper 
to  inflict  some  punishment  on  such  as  re- 
turned to  a  secular  life.  The  civil  law 
excludes  deserters  from  the  privilege  of 
ordination.  •  Justinian  added  another  punish- 
ment ;  which  was,  that  if  they  were  pos- 
sessed of  any  substance,  it  should  be  all 
forfeited  to  the  monastery  which  they  had 
deserted.  The  censures  of  the  Church  were 
likewise  inflicted  on  deserting  monks  in 
the  fifth  century. — Bingham,  book  vii.  c. 
iii. ;  Bobertson,  Ch.  Hist.  vol.  i.  (For  the 
diBerent  orders  of  monks  in  Western 
Christendom  after  the  sixth  century,  see 
under  their  several  names,  Benedictines, 
Carthusians,  Cistercians,  &c. 

MONOGRAM,  THE  SACRED.  The 
name  of  our  Lord  in  short.  The  original 
form  was  the  X  intersected  by  the  P,  the 
two  first  letters  of  xP'-"^"^-  Later  on  the 
X  was  turned  into  the  Egyptian  T,  the  P 
being  still  kept  on  the  top  ;  and  this  was 
called  the  Taw-cross.  Afterwards  the  letter 
P  began  to  be  disused,  and  the  X  was 
retained  only  in  the  form  of  a  Latin  or 
Greek  cross.  The  letters  A  and  Q,  the 
Beginning  and  the  Ending  (Rev.  i.  8)  are 
ofttn  displayed  with  the  cross,  or  used  by 
themselves.  To  this  monogram  St.  Clement 
of  Alexandria  and  TertuUian  allude.    Later 


MONOTIIELITES 


5G0 


monograms  were  the  I.  H.  C.  and  I.  H.  S. 
being  the  first  three  letters  of  the  Holy 
Name.     (See  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.)     [H.] 

MONOPHYSrrES.  (From  ,j.6vos,  only,. 
and  (bi(Tis,  nature.)  A  general  name  given 
to  all  those  sectaries  in  the  Levant  who 
only  own  one  nature  in  our  blessed  Saviour, 
and  who  maintain  that  the  Divine  and 
human  nature  of  Jesus  Christ  were  so  united 
as  to  form  only  one  nature,  yet  without  any 
change,  confusion,  or  mixture  of  the  two 
natures.  Eutyches  was  the  originator  of 
the  heresy  that  ascribed  but  one  nature  to 
Christ,  and  after  him  Dioscorus,  patriarch 
of  Alexandria,  was  its  chief  supporter.  He 
was  deposed  by  the  Council  of  Chalcedon, 
A.D.  451,  and  Proterius,  arch-priest  of  Alex- 
andria, was  chosen  his  successor.  But  a 
number  of  the  Alexandrians  held  to  Dios- 
corus, though  their  opinions  were  modified, 
and  from  this  time  they  assumed  or  received 
the  name  of  Monophysites.  They  afterwards 
split  into  other  sects,  and  did  much  mischief 
in  the  Churches  of  Syria  and  Egypt.  In 
later  ages  they  were  called  Jacobites.  (See 
Eutychians  ;  Jacobites. —  Stubbs'  Soames 
Mosheim,  i.  377,  378) ;  ii.  545,  546  ;  Blunt, 
Tlteol.  Diet.  S.Y.     [H.] 

MONOTH  ELITES.  Christian  heretics 
in  the  seventh  century,  so  called  from  the 
Greek  words  fiovos  {only)  and  6e\T]fj.a  (will), 
because  they  maintained,  that,  though 
there  were  two  natures  in  Jesus  Christ, 
the  human  and  the  Divine,  there  was  but 
one  will,  which  was  the  Divine. 

The  author  of  this  sect  was  Theodore,, 
bishop  of  Pharan  in  Arabia,  in  626,  whO' 
first  started  the  question,  and  maintained 
that  the  manhood  in  Christ  was  so  united 
to  the  Word,  that,  though  it  had  its  facul- 
ties, it  did  not  act  by  itself,  but  the  whole 
act  was  to  be  ascribed  to  the  Word,  which 
gave  it  the  motion.  Thus,  he  said,  it  was 
the  manhood  of  Christ  that  suffered  hunger,, 
thirst,  and  pain;  but  the  hunger,  thirst, 
and  pain  were  to  be  ascribed  to  the  Word. 
In  sliort,  the  Word  was  the  sole  author 
and  mover  of  all  the  operations  and  wills 
in  Christ. 

He  was  followed  by  Sergius,  patriarch  of 
Constantinople,  and  many  others;  and  the 
emperor  Heraclius  embraced  the  party  so 
much  the  more  willingly,  as  he  thought  it. 
a  means  of  reconciling  some  other  heretics- 
to  the  Church. 

Pope  Martin  I.  called  a  council  at  Rome 
in  649,  upon  the  question  about  the  two 
operations  and  two  wills.  In  this  council, 
which  was  held  in  the  church  of  St.  John 
of  the  Lateran,  and  thence  called  the 
'Lateran  Council,  and  at  which  were  present 
105  Italian  bishops,  the  doctrine  of  the 
Monothelites  was  generally  condemned.. 
The  emperor  Constans,  who  looked  upon 


510 


MONTANISTS 


this  condemnation  as  a  kind  of  reljellion, 
caused  Pope  Martin  to  be  violently  carried 
away  from  Rome,  and,  after  most  cruel 
usage,  banished  him  to  Chersona. 

But  the  heresy  was  finally  condemned  in 
the  sixth  general  council,  held  at  Constanti- 
nople, under  Constantine  Pogonatus,  in  the 
year  680.— Cave,  Hist.  Lit.  1605  ;  Stubbs' 
Soames' Jlfos/ieim,  i.  464,  467  (See  Church, 
■Qreeh  Orthodox). 

MONTANISTS.  Christian  heretics,  so 
■called  from  their  leader,  Montanus,  a  Phry- 
gian by  birth,  whence  they  are  sometimes 
styled  Phrygians  and  Cataphrygians.  He 
began  to  teach  publicly  according  to  Epi- 
phanius  in  A.D.  156 ;  but  according  to 
Eusebius,  172. — Epiphan.  Exr.  h.  33  ; 
Euseb.  V.  3. 

Montanus  pretended  to  inspiration,  and 
gave  out  that  the  Holy  Ghost  had  in- 
structed him  in  several  points  which  had 
not  been  revealed  to  the  apostles.  Priscilla 
and  Maximilla,  two  enthusiastic  women  of 
Phrygia,  presently  became  his  disciples,  and 
in  a  short  time  he  had  a  great  number  of 
followers.  It  is  easy  to  account  for  the  popu- 
larity of  Montanus.  He  had  prophecies  and 
supernatural  converse  for  the  credulous,  and 
rigid  austerities  for  the  severe.  It  was  the 
last  that  fascinated  TertuUian  and  made 
him  a  Montanist.  The  bishops  of  Asia,  being 
assembled  together,  condemned  the  doc- 
trines of  Montanus,  and  excommunicated 
those  who  dispersed  them.  Afterwards, 
they  wrote  an  account  of  what  had  passed 
to  the  Western  Churches,  where  the  pre- 
tended prophecies  of  Montanus  and  his 
followers  were  likewise  condemned. 

The  Montanists,  finding  themselves  ex- 
posed to  the  censure  of  the  whole  Church, 
formed  a  schism,  and  set  up  a  distinct 
society,  under  the  direction  of  those  who 
called  themselves  prophets.  Montanus,  in 
conjunction  with  Priscilla  and  Maximilla, 
was  at  the  head  of  the  sect. 

These  sectaries  made  no  alteration  in  the 
creed.  They  only  held  that  the  Holy 
■Spirit  made  Montanus  His  organ  for  de- 
livering a  more  perfect  form  of  disciphne 
than  that  which  was  delivered  by  the 
apostles.  They  refused  communion  for 
ever  to  those  who  were  guilty  of  notorious 
■crimes,  and  believed  that  the  bishops  had 
no  authority  to  reconcile  them.  They  held 
it  unlawful  to  fly  in  time  of  persecution. 
They  condemned  second  marriages,  allowed 
the  dissolution  of  marriage,  and  observed 
three  Lents.  Nothing  is  heard  of  the 
Montanists  after  the  6th  century. — Stubbs ' 
Soames'  Mosheim,  i.  153 ;  Diet.  Christ.  Biog. 
s.  V.  Montanus. 

MONUMENT.  The  memorial  placed 
over  the  body  of  a  Christian,  after  his 
burial  in  consecrated  ground. 


MONUMENT 

The  earliest  monuments  in  England 
which  have  come  down  to  us  are,  perhaps, 
not  older  than  the  Norman  Conquest ;  and 
the  most  ancient  is  the  simplest  form.  A 
stone  coffin  is  covered  with  a  single  stone 
slab,  which  is  also  the  only  recipient  of 
whatever  device  may  be  designed  to  com- 
memorate the  tenant  of  the  narrow  dwel- 
ling over  which  it  closes.  So  early  as  the 
middle  of  the  ninth  century  (840),  Kenneth, 
king  of  Scotland,  made  an  ordinance  that 
such  coffins  should  be  adorned  with  the 
sign  of  the  cross,  in  token  of  sanctity,  on 
which  no  one  was  on  any  account  to  tread ; 
and,  perhaps,  there  were  none  but  purely 
religious  emblems  employed  for  some  genera- 
tions after  this  time.  The  sign  of  the  cross 
still  continued  for  centuries  the  most  usual 
ornament  of  tombs,  but  by-and-by  it  be- 
came associated  \vith  others  which  were 
most  of  them  intended  to  designate  the  pro- 
fession of  him  whose  diist  they  honoured. 
Hence  we  have  the  crosier  and  mitre,  with 
perhaps  a  chalice  and  paten,  upon  the  tomb 
of  an  ecclesiastic,  of  an  abbot,  or  a  bishop ; 
the  knight  has  a  sword,  and  his  shield  at 
first  plain,  but  afterwards  charged  with  his 
arms  on  his  tomb.  Sometimes  an  approach 
to  religious  allegory  is  discovered  on  monu- 
ments even  of  these  very  early  ages,  such 
as,  for  instance,  the  cross  or  crosier  stuck 
into  the  mouth  of  a  serpent  or  cockatrice, 
indicating  the  victory  of  the  cross  and  of 
the  Church  over  the  devil.  These,  and  the 
like  devices,  occurring  before  any  attempt 
at  the  human  figure  was  made,  are  in  a  low 
relief,  or  intended  outline. 

By-and-by  the  human  figure  was  added, 
recumbent,  and  arrayed  in  the  dress  of  the 
individual  commemorated ;  and  this  figiu:e 
soon  rose  from  low  relief  to  an  effigy  in  full 
proportions.  The  knight  and  the  ecclesi- 
astic are  now  discovered  so  perfectly  attired 
according  to  their  order  and  degree,  that 
the  antiquary  gathers  his  knowledge  of 
costume  from  these  venerable  remains. 
Some  affecting  lessons  of  mortality  are  now 
forcibly  inculcated  by  circumstances  intro- 
duced into  the  sepulchre ;  for  instance,  the 
figure  of  the  deceased  appears  nearly  reduced 
to  a  skeleton,  and  laid  in  a  shroud ;  a  few 
instances  occur  in  which  the  corpse  thus 
represented  is  below  a  representation  of  the 
living  person.  Another  interesting  intima- 
tion of  the  character  of  the  deceased  appears 
in  the  crossed  legs  of  those  who  had  vowed 
a  pilgrimage  to  the  Holy  Land;  and  the 
lion  is  frequently  found,  as  well  as  the 
serpent,  at  the  feet  of  the  recumbent  figure, 
perhaps  in  allusion  to  the  words  of  the 
psalmist,  "  Thou  shalt  tread  upon  the  lion 
and  adder  :  the  young  lion  and  the  dragon 
shalt  thou  trample  under  thy  feet." 
All  this  time  the  tomb  has  been  gradu- 


MONUMENT 

ally  increasing  in  height  and  in  general 
splendour,  the  sides  are  adorned  with 
figures  in  several  compartments,  which 
run  into  niches  or  panels,  according  to  the 
advance  of  architectural  design,  and  at  last 
they  are  surmounted  with  an  arch,  low  at 
first  and  little  decorated,  but  afterwards 
very  elaborately  ■(vrought  into  a  rich  ca- 
nopy. Religious  allegories  become  more 
complex  on  the  sides  of  the  tomb,  and  we 
have  instances  of  some  which  have  since 
been  borrowed  by  artists  of  name,  and 
perhaps  accounted  new  by  many ;  for  in- 
stance, it  is  not  rare  to  see  a  representation 
of  the  soul  of  the  dying  conveyed  to  heaven 
by  angels,  while  the  corpse  lies  upon  the 
litter,  and  this  was  a  design  chosen  for  the 
cenotaph  of  the  Princess  Charlotte.  The 
relatives  of  the  deceased  are  sometimes  re- 
presented by  many  small  statues  in  the 
niches ;  or  armorial  bearings  are  introduced, 
sparing  at  first,  and  often,  as  on  the  tomb  of 
Lionell  Lord  Wells,  in  Methley  church, 
supported  on  the  breasts  of  angels.  Angels 
also  frequently  support  the  head  of  the  re- 
cumbent figure,  and  at  the  feet  are  some- 
times one  or  more  priests  with  an  open  book 
in  their  hands.  The  space  in  the  wall 
behind  the  tomb  and  beneath  the  canopy 
allows  of  allegorical  devices,  sometimes  in 
fresco,  sometimes  in  mosaic.  But  what 
most  demands  attention  are  the  recumbent 
figures  themselves,  generally  with  both 
hands  raised  in  the  attitude  of  prayer;  or,  if 
they  be  bishops,  with  the  right  hand  as  if 
giving  a  blessing.  The  effigies  of  the  man 
a.nd  his  wife  appear  always  on  the  same 
tomb,  lying  side  by  side,  and  in  the  same 
pious  attitude  ;  a  frequently  recurring  sight, 
which  inspired  the  lines  of  Piers  Plowman : — 

■"  Itrtggljt?  irt  tijcr  CDrttsartcc  clali  far  tfje  ttortes, 
aiit  it  stmclr  acgntes  psactclr  opon  crtfjt, 
anU   loijelg  laStts   Bbirnugfjt  Icgm  bg  i^ct 

stBts." 
And  surely  there  is  a  beauty  and  pro- 
priety in  that  character  of  monuments  for 
•Christian  men  in  Christian  churches,  which 
■could  suggest  the  words, 

"  Wk  it  semes  gegntes  psacreS  npmi  ertfjc," 
far  greater  than  we  recognise  in  the  vain- 
glorious boastings  of  success  In  secular  pur- 
suits, perhaps  even  in  sinful  imdertakings, 
which  now  cumber  church  walls.  It  is  a 
hoher  thought  to  remember  what  was  sacred 
in  the  Christian  man ;  who,  imperfect  as  he 
may  have  been,  was  yet,  as  he  was  a  Chris- 
tian, in  some  sense  a  saint,  and  to  embody  it 
in  some  pious  attitude  upon  his  tomb,  than 
-to  forget  everything  that  is  Christian,  and 
to  celebrate  only  the  secular  or  the  vicious. 
Gorgeous  as  some  of  these  tombs  are,  they 
■did  not  satisfy  the  splendour  of  that  age, 
and  the  canopy  swells  into  an  actual  chapel, 


MORALITIES 


511 


sometimes  in  the  body  of  the  larger  church, 
as  that  of  William  of  Wykeham,  in  Win- 
chester, and  those  of  Cardinal  Beaufort,  and 
Bishops  Waynflete  and  Pox,  in  the  same 
cathedral.  Sometimes  the  chapel  is  a 
building  complete  in  itself,  as  that  of  the 
Beauchamps,  at  St.  Mary's  church,  Warwick, 
and  that  of  Henry  VII.  at  Westminster. 

MONUMENTS  cannot  legally  be  put 
in  any  church,  nor  strictly  in  a  churchyard, 
without  a  faculty,  but  that  is  generally 
waived  as  to  churchyards.  When  once  up 
they  are  held  to  belong  to  the  heir-at-law  of 
the  person,  and  not  to  his  pei-sonal  repre- 
sentatives even  though  they  have  paid  for 
them.  But  the  heirs  cannot  be  compelled 
to  keep  them  in  repair,  nor  is  anybody  else 
bound  to  do  so.  If  not  kept  in  repair  by 
them  they  can  probably  be  dealt  with  by 
churchwardens  as  obstructions  and  rubbish 
if  they  have  become  ruinous ;  and  they  can 
certainly  be  removed  in  restorations  of  a 
church  under  a  faculty,  if  no  legal  owner  of 
them  has  opposed  it.  They  were  often  put 
in  such  a  reckless  way  in  former  times,  with- 
out caring  how  much  they  interfered  with 
the  proper  use  of  the  church,  that  it  is  often 
necessary  to  remove  them  into  other  places 
either  inside  or  outside  of  the  church,  and 
faculties  provide  for  so  doing.  The  fashion 
of  putting  up  wooden  hatchments  of  coats  of 
arms  of  dead  people  in  churches  was  illegal, 
and  is  happily  extinct,  and  most  of  them 
are  burnt  by  this  time.  There  was  also  a 
curious  fancy  for  putting  up  a  hatchment 
of  the  royal  arms  somewhere  in  churches, 
which  have  all  hkewise  perished,  or  very 
nearly  so,  under  restorations.  It  has  been 
held  that  persons  unlawfully  removing 
monuments  are  liable  to  an  action  by  the 
heir,  and  also  to  a  monition  in  the  ecclesi- 
astical court.  And  by  2i  &  25  Vict.  c.  97, 
s.  39,  whoever  unlawfully  and  maliciously 
destroys  or  injures  any  monument  or  other 
memorial  of  the  dead,  or  painted  window, 
&c.,  or  other  work  of  art  in  a  church  or  church- 
yard, may  be  imprisoned  with  hard  labour 
for  sis  months,  and  whipped  if  under  six- 
teen years  of  age.     [Gr.] 

MOEALITIES,  MYSTERIES,  and 
MIRACLES.  A  kind  of  theatrical  re- 
presentations, which  were  made  by  the 
monks,  friars,  and  other  ecclesiastics  of  the 
middle  ages,  the  vehicle  of  instruction  to 
the  people.  Their  general  character  was 
the  same,  but  the  miracles  may  be  distin- 
guished as  those  which  represented  the 
miracles  wrought  by  the  holy  confessors, 
and  the  sufferings  by  which  the  persever- 
ance of  the  martyrs  was  manifested ;  of 
which  kind  the  first  specified  by  name  is 
a  scenic  representation  of  the  legend  of 
St.  Catherine.  The  moralities  were  certain 
allegorical  representations  of  virtues  or  vices. 


512 


MOBAVIANS 


always  so  coDtrived  as  to  make  virtue  seem 
desirable,  and  vice  ridiculous  and  de termed. 
The  mysteries  were  representations  often 
of  great  length,  and  requiring  several  days' 
performance,  of  the  Scripture  narrative,  or 
of  several  parts  of  it,  as,  for  instance,  the 
descent  of  Christ  into  hell.  Of  these  mys- 
teries two  complete  series  have  lately  been 
published  from  ancient  manuscripts,  the 
Toionley  Mysteries,  performed  by  the  monks 
of  Woodchurch,  near  Wakefield,  and  the 
different  leading  companies  of  that  town ; 
and  tlie  Coventry  Mysteries,  performed  with 
like  help  of  the  trades  in  Coventry,  by  the 
Grey  Friars  of  that  ancient  city.  Both  of 
these  collections  begin  with  the  creation, 
and  carry  on  the  story  in  different  pageants 
or  scenes  until  the  judgment-day. 

It  will  not  be  supposed  that  these  plays 
are  free  from  the  deformities  of  every  other 
kind  of  literature  of  the  times  to  which  they 
are  referred ;  nor  that  the  performance  of 
them  was  without  a  great  deal  more  of  the 
coarseness  of  an  unrefined  age  than  would 
be  tolerated  now ;  neither  need  it  be  con- 
cealed that  the  theology  therein  embodied 
was  sometimes  rather  Popish  than  Catholic. 

On  the  whole  it  may  fairly  be  said,  that 
these  miracles,  mysteries,  and  moralities, 
were  wholesome  for  the  times ;  and  that 
though  they  afterwards  degenerated  into 
actual  abuses,  yet  that  they  are  not  to  be 
condemned  without  measure  and  without 
mercy. 

Their  history  and  character  are  interest- 
ing, not  only  as  giving  a  fair  picture  of  the 
character  of  remote  ages,  but  also  because 
they  seem  to  be  the  original  from  which 
arose  stage  plays  and  oratorios.  The  sacred 
drama  of  our  Lord's  Passion,  performed  once 
in  ten  years  at  Ammergau  in  Bavaria,  is 
the  only  survival  of  the  media;val  mystery 
plays  ;  but  a  great  improvement  upon  them. 

As  a  specimen  of  these  old  moralities 
see  in  Dodsley's  collection  of  old  plays — 
God's  Promises,  by  Bale,  bishop  of  Ossory, 
which  dramatizes  the  leading  events  of  the 
Sacred  history.     It  was  printed  in  15.38. 

MORAVIANS,  or  UNITED  BEE- 
THBEN.  (1)  These  clahn  to  derive  their 
origin  from  the  Greek  Church  in  the  ninth 
century,  when,  by  the  instrumentality  of 
Methodius  and  CyriUus,  two  Greek  monks, 
the  kings  of  Bu^aria  and  Moravia,  being 
converted  to  the  faith,  were,  together  with 
their  subjects,  united  in  communion  with 
the  Greek  Church.  Methodius  was  their 
first  bishop,  and  for  their  use  CyriUus  trans- 
lated the  Scriptures  into  the  Sclavonian 
language.  Another  sect,  known  as  "Mo- 
ravian Brethren,"  was  part  of  that  more 
moderate  section  of  the  Taborites  which 
appeared  in  Prague  about  a.d.  1450.  After 
various  vicissitudes  they  were  driven  out  of 


MORAVIANS 

Bohemia  and  Moravia,  in  1627,  and  were 
disjiersed,  the  most  part  however  settling  in 
Poland.  They  had  nominally  bishops,  but 
consecration  in  the  first  place  had  only  been 
obtained  from  a  Waldensian  bishop  (see 
Waldenses).  The  very  name  "bishop" 
was  afterwards  changed  into  "  senior,"  and 
the  sect  subsided  iuto  an  ordinary  Presby- 
terian organization.  (2)  But  there  is  no 
real  historical  association  between  these  two 
sects  and  the  modern  Moravians,  who  started 
de  novo.  One  Christien  David,  a  Romanist 
of  Moravia,  driven  from  his  native  country, 
had  taken  shelter  in  Saxony.  There  he 
came  under  the  notice  of  Count  Zinzendorf, 
who  gave  him  land  in  his  estate  at  Berth- 
oldsdorf,  and  encouraged  him  to  found  a 
settlement  there,  which  increased  rapidly. 
In  1727  some  of  the  community  forsook 
their  parish  church,  and  held  meetings  in 
a  large  hall;  soon  elders  were  appointed, 
and  the  schism  was  complete.  They  called 
themselves  "  United  Brethi'en  " ;  but  were 
also  known  as  Herrnhutters,  from  the  name 
given  to  their  settlement — Hermhut,  the 
Watch  of  the  Lord.  Zinzendorf  travelled 
much  about,  establishing  settlements,  and 
he  visited  England  in  1737,  where  he 
became  acquainted  with  Charles  Wesley: 
but  the  influence  of  Moravianism  or  Method- 
ism was  exercised  through  the  intimacy 
of  John  Wesley  with  some  Moravians  he 
met  on  his  voyage  to  Georgia  (see  Metho- 
dists). Since  ZinzendorPs  deaih  in  1760, 
the  Moravians  have  not  much  increased : 
numbering  at  present  about  13,000  in 
Europe,  but  six  times  that  number  in  their 
missions.  The  settlement  at  Herrnhut  still 
continues;  in  England  there  are  settlements 
at  Fulneck  near  Leeds,  Fairfield  near 
Manchester,  and  Ockbrook  near  Derby. 

The  Moravians  prefer  Episcopacy  :  but 
their  first  bishops,  Nitschmann  and  Zinzen- 
dorf, were  consecrated  by  Jablonsky,  chap- 
lain to  the  King  of  Prussia,  whose  only 
authority  was  that  he  was  the  "  senior  "  of 
the  dispersed  "  brethren  "  of  1627.  Zinzen- 
dorf asserted,  and  endeavoured  to  prove, 
their  claims  to  apostolic  succession,  in  a 
folio  volume  published  in  1749,  under  title 
"Acta  Fratrum  Unitatis  in  Anglia."  (3) 
The  Moravians  acknowledged  no  other 
standard  of  truth  than  the  Holy  Scriptures,, 
though  they  in  general  profess  to  adhere 
to  the  Augsburg  Confession.  They  believe- 
implicitly  in  the  doctrine  of  the  Trinity; 
and  in  their  prayers,  hymns,  and  litanies 
address  the  Father,  Son,  and  Holy  Ghost, 
in  the  same  manner  as  is  done  in  other 
Christian  Churches ;  yet  they  chiefly  direct 
their  hearers  to  Jesus  Christ,  as  the  ap- 
pointed channel  of  the  Deity,  in  whom  God 
is  known  and  made  manifest  unto  man. 
They  recommend  love  to  him,  as  the  con- 


MOKMOXS 

straining  principle  of  the  Christian's  con- 
duct ;  and  their  general  manner  is  more  by 
beseeching  mi-n  to  be  reconciled  to  God, 
than  by  alarming  them  with  the  terrors  of 
the  law,  and  the  threatenings  against  the 
impenitent.  They  avoid,  as  much  as  pos- 
sible, everything  that  would  lead  to  contro- 
versy; and  though  they  strongly  insist 
upon  salvation  by  grace  alone  through  faith, 
yet  they  will  not  enter  iuto  any  explana- 
tion, or  give  any  decided  opinion,  concern- 
ing particular  election.  They  profess  to 
believe  that  the  kingdom  of  Christ  is  not 
confined  to  any  party,  community,  or 
Church;  and  they  consider  themselves, 
though  closely  united  in  one  body  or  visible 
Church,  as  spiritually  joined  in  the  bond  of 
Christian  love  to  all  who  are  taught  of  God, 
and  belong  to  the  universal  Church  of  Christ, 
however  much  they  may  differ  in  forms, 
which  they  deem  non-essentials. 

See  Crantz's  History  of  the  Brethren,  La 
Trobe's  Trans. ;  Spangenberg's  Kxpositlon 
of  Christian  Doctrine;  Ratio  DiscipUma 
Unit.  Fratrum,  by  Lorentz. 

MORMONS :  MORMONISTS.  The 
name  of  a  sect  founded  in  America  by 
Joseph  Smith  in  1830.  The  derivation  of 
the  word,  according  to  Smith,  is  mar,  con- 
traction from  more,  and  mon,  Egyptian  for 
good.  The  Mormons  call  themselves  also 
"  Latter  Day  Saints."  Smith  was  an 
ignorant  lustful  man,  who  however  pre- 
tended angelic  guidance,  under  which  he 
said  that  he  discovered  certain  hidden  gold 
plates  on  which  were  written  records  from 
the  time  of  the  dispersion  at  Babel.  The 
plates  were  not  allowed  to  be  inspected,  but 
from  them  Smith  pretended  to  dictate  the 
"  Book  of  Mormon,"  which  was  published  in 
1830.  It  was  really  a  garbled  version  of 
an  extravagant  romance  written  by  one 
Spalding,  the  MS.  of  which  had  fallen  into 
the  hands  of  Eigdon,  one  of  Smith's 
partners.  The  first  settlement  of  Latter 
Day  Saints  was  at  Manchester,  New  York  ; 
from  whence  they  were  di'iveu  in  con- 
sequence of  a  swindling  transaction  by  their 
prophet.  They  settled  in  Illinois,  and 
called  their  town  Nauvoo,  the  city  of 
beauty,  where  in  1844  Smith  was,  for  his 
iniquities,  shot  by  a  Lynch  mob.  Brigham 
Young  was  elected  prophet,  but  the  feeling 
was  strong  against  the  Mormons,  and  the 
whole  community  migrated  westward  to  a 
place  in  the  valley  of  the  great  Salt  Lake 
in  Upper  California,  to  which  the  name 
Utah  was  given.  Hither  a  great  number  of 
people  flocked,  and  it  is  said  that  at  least 
50,000  English  people  belong  to  the  com- 
munity, la  1852  the  law  authorising 
polygamy  was  promulgated,  though  before 
this  the  practice  had  been  tacitly  allowed 
in  consequence  of  an  alleged  "  revelation  " 


MORTMAIN 


513 


to  J.  Smith  in  1843.  In  1871  the  United 
States  prosecuted  the  Mormon  leaders  for 
bigamy,  but  for  some  technical  reason, 
without  result.  Brigham  Young  died  in 
1879.  At  present  it  would  seem  doubtful 
whether  the  community  at  Utah  will 
continue  to  exist.  The  members  talk  of 
removing,  and  the  Republicans  in  the 
United  States  desire  to  "  put  down  the 
Saints." 

The  faith  and  doctrine  of  the  Mormons 
is  based  on  very  gross  materialism.  The 
Supreme  Deity  is  material,  and  by  con- 
stant development  has  attained  omnipo- 
tence. There  are  three  persons  in  the 
Godhead,  each  separate  and  distinct  from 
the  others,  equal  in  knowledge,  &c.  God 
has  a  wife,  and  family,  consisting  of  count- 
less Gods  of  different  dignity  and  powei\ 
But  it  is  not  necessary  here  to  give  the 
details  of  a  religion,  in  which  simple  faith, 
gross  materialism,  fantastic  and  blasphemous 
theories,  and  the  greatest  sensuality  are 
combined. — Burton's  City  of  the  Saints ; 
Mormonism,  by  W.  J.  Conybeare  ;  Edin. 
Rev.  No.  202  ;  Blunt's  Diet,  of  Sects.     [H.] 

MORTAL  SIN  (See  Deadly  Sin). 

MORTIFICATION.  Any  severe  pen 
ance  observed  on  a  religious  account.  The 
mortification  of  sin  in  believers  is  a  duty 
enjoined  in  the  sacred  Scriptures  (Rom. 
viii.  13  ;  Col.  iii.  5).  It  consists  in 
breaking  the  league  with  sin ;  declaration 
of  open  hostility  against  it;  and  strong 
resistance  to  it  (Eph.  vi.  10,  &c. ;  Gal.  v. 
24 ;  Rom.  viii.  13). 

MORTMAIN  {Morte  Main,  i.e.  dead 
hand).  Possession  of  lands  and  tenement;, 
in  hands  that  cannot  alienate.  Originally 
applied  to  conveyances  of  land  to  ecclesiasti- 
cal bodies.  That  is  to  say  where  lands  were 
given  to  some  spiritual  person  or  corpora- 
tion and  to  their  successors ;  and  because 
by  that  means  the  services  and  other 
profits  due  for  the  same  were  extinct, 
therefore  it  was  called  a  gift  in  mortua 
manu. 

The  first  statute  against  mortmain  was 
that  of  Magna  Carta  (9  Hen.  III.  c.  36), 
which  declares,  "  that  if  any  one  shall  give 
lands  to  a  religious  house,  the  grant  shall 
be  void,  and  the  land  forfeited  to  the  lord 
of  the  fee."  The  next  was  the  7  Edw.  I. 
Stat,  ii.,  commonly  called  the  statute  "  De 
Religiosis,"  which  restrained  people,  at  the 
time  of  their  death  or  otherwise,  from 
giving  or  making  over  any  lands  or  rents 
to  churches  or  religious  houses,  without  the 
king's  leave  first  obtained.  This  is  called 
the  Statute  of  Mortmain  ;  but  being  evaded, 
the  13  of  Edw.  I.  was  passed,  and  after- 
wards by  the  15  Rich.  II.  c.  5,  it  was 
declared,  "  that  it  was  within  the  compass 
of  the  statute  of  Edward  I.  to  convert  any 

2  L 


514 


MORTMAIN 


land  into  a  cliurchyard,  though  it  he  done 
with  the  consent  or  connivance  of  tlie 
ter-tenant,  and  confirmed  hy  the  pope's 
bull." 

This  last  statute  extended  only  to  bodies 
corporate,  and,  therefore,  by  the  23  Hen. 
VIII.  c.  10, '  it  is  enacted,  "  that  if  any 
grants  of  lands  or  other  hereditaments 
should  be  made  in  trust  to  the  use  of  any 
churches,  chapels,  churchwardens,  guilds, 
fraternities,  &c.,  to  have  perpetual  obits, 
or  a  continual  service  of  a  priest  for  ever, 
or  for  sixty  or  eighty  years,  or  to  such 
like  uses  or  intents,  all  such  uses,  intents, 
and  purposes  shall  be  void;  they  being 
no  corporations,  but  erected  either  of  de- 
votion, or  else  by  the  common  consent  of 
the  people:  and  all  collateral  assurances 
made  for  defeating  this  statute  shall  be 
void,  and  the  said  statute  shall  be  ex- 
pounded most  beneficially  for  the  destruc- 
tion of  such  uses  as  aforesaid." 

Though  the  prohibition  by  the  Statute 
of  Mortmain  in  Magna  Carta  was  ab- 
solute, yet  a  royal  charter  of  licence  (18 
Edw.  III.  stat.  iii.  c.  3)  afforded  relaxation 
of  the  restraint,  and  by  the  17  Car.  II. 
c.  3,  the  following  relief  was  granted  : — 
"Every  owner  of  any  impropriations, 
tithes,  or  portion  of  tithes,  in  any  parish 
or  chapelry,  may  give  and  annex  the  same, 
or  any  part  thereof,  unto  the  parsonage 
or  vicarage  of  the  said  parish  church  or 
chapel  where  the  same  do  lie  or  arise ;  or 
settle  the  same  in  trust  for  the  benefit  of 
the  said  parsonage  or  vicarage,  or  of  the 
curate  and  curates  there  successively, 
where  the  parsonage  is  impropriate  and  no 
vicar  endowed,  without  any  licence  of  mort- 
main. 

"  And  if  the  settled  maintenance  of  any 
parsonage,  vicarages,  churches,  and  chapels 
united,  or  of  any  other  parsonage  or 
vicarage  with  cure,  shall  not  amount  to  the 
full  sum  of  £100  a  year  clear  and  above 
all  charges  and  reprises,  it  shall  be  lawful 
for  the  parson,  vicar,  and  incumbent  of  the 
same,  and  his  successors,  to  take  and 
purchase  to  him  and  his  successors  lands 
and  tenements,  rents,  tithes,  or  other  here- 
ditaments, without  any  hcence  of  mort- 
main." This  dispensing  power  was  carried 
so  high  in  the  reign  of  King  James  II.,  that 
by  the  1  Wm.  III.  sess.  ii.  c.  2,  it  was  en- 
acted, that  no  dispensation,  by  "non 
obstante,"  to  any  statute  shall  be  allowed. 
By  the  7  &  8  Wm.  IIL  c.  37,  and  2  &  3 
Anne,  c.  11,  certain  relaxations  were  again 
made ;  but  by  the  9  Greo.  II.  c.  36,  further 
restraints  were  imposed,  which  render  it 
impossible  for  the  Church  of  England  to 
augment  poor  livings,  under  the  provisions 
of  17  Car.  II.  c.  3,  already  recited  (But  see 
Clmrch  Building  Acts). 


MOETUAEY 

By  12  &  13  Vict.  c.  49,  s.  4,  grants  of 
land  for  sites  of  schools,  not  exceeding  five 
acres,  made  by  owners  or  tenants  in  tail 
are  valid,  although  the  grantor  die  within 
twelve  months. 

MOETUAKY  (Mwtuarium),  in  the 
English  Ecclesiastical  law,  is  a  gift  left  by 
a  man  at  his  death  to  his  parish  church, 
in  recompense  of  personal  tithes  omitted  to 
be  paid  in  his  life-time ;  or,  it  is  that 
beast,  or  other  cattle,  which  after  the 
death  of  the  owner,  by  the  custom  of  the 
place,  is  due  to  the  parson  or  vicar,  in  lieu 
of  tithes  or  offerings  forgot,  or  not  well  and 
truly  paid  by  him  that  is  dead. 

Selden  tells  us,  it  was  usual  anciently  to- 
bring  the  mortuary  along  with  the  corpse, 
when  it  came  to  be  buried,  and  to  offer  it  to 
the  Church  as  a  satisfaction  for  the 
supposed  negligence  and  omission  the 
deceased  had  been  guilty  of  in  not  paying 
his  personal  tithes ;  and  from  thence  it  was 
called  a  "  corse  present." 

A  mortuary  is  not  properly  due  to  an 
ecclesiastical  incumbent  from  any  but  those 
of  his  own  parish ;  but  by  custom,  in  some 
places,  they  are  paid  to  the  incumbents  of 
other  parishes,  when  corpses  are  carried 
through  them.  The  bishops  of  Bangor,. 
Llandaff,  St.  David's,  &c.,  had  formerly 
mortuaries  of  priests,  abolished  by  12  Anne, 
stat.  ii.  c.  6.  And  it  was  customary,  in 
the  diocese  of  Chester,  for  the  bishop  to 
have  a  mortuary,  on  the  death  of  every 
priest  dying  within  the  archdeaconry  of 
Chester,  of  his  best  beast,  saddle  and 
bridle,  and  best  gown  or  cloak,  hat,  and 
upper  garment  under  the  gown.  By  28 
Geo.  II.  c.  6,  mortuaries  in  the  diocese  of 
Chester  were  abolished,  and  the  rectory  of 
Waverton  attached  to  the  see  in  lieu 
thereof.  By  the  21  Hen.  VIII.  c.  6, 
mortuaries  were  commuted  into  money 
payments,  which  were  regulated  as  follows  : 
— "  No  parson,  vicar,  curate,  parish  priest, 
or  other,  shall  for  any  person  dying  or 
dead,  and  being  at  the  time  of  his  death  of 
the  value  in  moveable  goods  of  ten  marks 
or  more,  clearly  above  his  debts  paid,  and 
under  the  sum  of  £30,  take  for  a  mortuary 
above  3s.  id.  in  the  whole.  And  for  a 
person  dying  or  dead,  being  at  the  time  of 
his  death  of  the  value  of  £30  or  above, 
clearly  above-  his  debts  paid,  in  moveable 
goods,  and  under  the  value  of  £40,  there 
shall  no  more  be  taken  or  demanded  for  a 
mortuary,  than  6s.  8d.  in  the  whole.  And 
for  any  person  dying  or  dead,  having  at  the 
time  of  his  death  of  the  value  in  moveable 
goods  of  £40  or  above,  to  any  sum  what- 
soever it  be  clearly  above  his  debts  paid, 
there  shall  be  no  more  taken,  paid,  or 
demanded  for  a  mortuary,  than  10s.  in  the 
whole.     The  Welsh  bishoprics  and  the  dio- 


MOTETT 

cese  of  Chester  were  excepted  from  the 
operation  of  this  statute,  and  therefore 
subsequent  Acts  were  passed  with  respect  to 
them. 

MOTETT,  in  Church  music,  a  short 
piece  of  music  highly  elaborated,  of  which 
the  subject  is  taken  from  the  psalms  or 
hymns  of  the  Church.  The  derivation  is 
from  the  Italian  Mottetto,  a  little  word  or 
sentence ;  originally  signifying  a  short  epi- 
gram in  verse;  and  afterwards  apphed  as 
now  defined,  as  the  words  of  the  Motett 
properly  consist  of  a  short  sentence  from 
Holy  Scripture. 

MOTHER  OP  GOD  (See  Mariolatry ; 
Virgin  Mary ;  Nestorians).  "  The  Virgin 
Mary,"  says  Pearson,  "  is  frequently  styled 
the  Mother  of  Jesus  in  the  language  of  the 
evangelists,  and  by  Elizabeth  particularly, 
the  Mother  of  our  Lord,  as  also,  by  the 
general  consent  of  the  Church,  because  He 
which  was  born  of  her  was  God,  the 
Deipara;  which,  being  a  compound  title, 
begun  in  the  Greek  Church,  was  resolved 
into  its  parts  by  the  Latins,  and  so  the 
Virgin  was  plainly  named  the  Mother  of 
God." 

The  term  was  first  brought  prominently 
forward  at  the  Council  of  Ephesus  (a.d. 
431),  the  third  of  those  four  general  councils, 
the  decisions  of  which  are  authoritative  in 
the  Church  of  England ;  and  it  was  adopted 
as  a  formula  against  the  Nestorians.  The 
Nestorian  controversy  originated  thus.  In 
the  year  428,  Nestorius  was  bishop  of 
Constantinople,  and  he  had  brought  with 
him  from  Antioch,  where  he  had  before 
resided,  a  priest  named  Anastasius,  his 
chaplain  and  friend ;  this  pei'son,  preaching 
one  day  in  the  Church  of  Constantinople, 
said,  "Let  no  one  call  Mary  mother  of 
God,  for  she  was  a  woman,  and  it  is  im- 
possible that,  God  should  be  bom  of  a 
human  creature."  These  words  gave  great 
offence  to  many  both  of  the  clergy  and 
laity;  for  they  had  always  been  taught, 
says  the  historian  Socrates,  to  acknowledge 
Jesus  Christ  as  God,  and  not  to  sever  Him 
in  any  way  from  the  Divinity.  Nestorius, 
however,  declared  bis  assent  to  what 
Anastasius  had  said,  and  became,  from  his 
high  position  in  the  Church,  the  heresiarch. 

When  the  heresy  had  spread  into  Egypt, 
it  was  refuted  by  St.  Cyril,  bishop  of 
Alexandria,  in  a  pastoral  letter,  which  he 
published  for  the  direction  of  his  people. 
"  I  wonder,"  he  says,  "  how  a  question 
can  be  raised,  as  to  whether  the  Holy 
Virgin  should  be  called  Mother  of  God; 
for  if  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ  is  God,  how  is 
not  the  Holy  Virgin,  His  mother,  the 
mother  of  God  ?  This  is  the  faith  we  have 
been  taught  by  the  Apostles."  He  next 
proves  that  He  who  was  bom  of  the  Virgin 


MOTHER  OF  GOD 


515 


Mary  is  God  in  His  own  nature,  since  the 
Nicene  Creed  says  that  the  only  begotten 
Son  of  God,  of  the  same  substance  with  the 
Father,  Himself  came  down  from  Heaven 
and  was  incarnate ;  and  then  he  proceeds, 
"  You  will  say,  perhaps,  is  the  Virgin,  then, 
mother  of  the  Divinity  ?  We  answer,  it  is 
certain  that  the  Word  is  eternal,  and  of  the 
substance  of  the  Father.  Now,  in  the  order 
of  nature,  mothers,  who  have  no  part  in  the 
creation  of  the  soul,  are  still  called  mothers  of 
the  whole  man,  and  not  of  the  body  only  ; 
for  surely  it  would  be  a  hypercritical  refine- 
ment to  say,  Elizabeth  is  mother  of  the 
body  of  John,  and  not  of  his  soul.  In  the 
same  way,  therefore,  we  express  ourselves 
in  regard  to  the  birth  of  Emmanuel,  since 
the  Word,  having  taken  flesh  upon  Him,  is 
called  Son  of  Man."  In  a  letter  to 
Nestorius  himself  he  enters  into  a  fuller 
explanation :  "  We  must  admit  in  the  same 
Christ  two  generations :  first,  the  eternal, 
by  which  He  proceeds  from  His  Father; 
second,  the  temporal,  by  which  He  is  born 
of  His  mother.  When  we  say  that  He 
suffered  and  rose  again,  we  do  not  say  that 
God  the  Word  suffered  in  His  own  nature, 
for  the  Divinity  is  impassible ;  but  because 
the  body  which  was  appropriated  to  Him 
suffered,  so  also  we  say  that  He  suffered  Him- 
self. So  too  we  say  He  died.  The  Divine 
Word  is  in  His  own  nature  immortal.  He 
is  life  itself;  but  because  His  own  true 
body  suffered  death,  we  say  that  He  Himself 
died  for  ns.  In  the  same  way,  when  His 
flesh  is  raised  from  the  dead,  we  attribute 
resurrection  to  Him.  We  do  not  say  that 
we  adore  the  man  along  with  the  Word, 
lest  the  phrase  '  along  with '  should  suggest 
the  idea  of  non-identity ;  but  we  adore  Him 
as  one  and  the  same  person,  because  the 
body  assumed  by  the  Word  is  in  no  degree 
external  or  separated  from  the  Word."  "  It 
is  in  this  sense,"  he  says  afterwards,  "  that 
the  Fathers  have  ventured  to  call  the  Holy 
Virgin  mother  of  God,  not  that  the  nature 
of  the  Word,  or  His  Divinity,  did  receive 
beginning  of  His  existence  from  the  Holy 
Virgin,  but  because  in  her  was  formed  and 
animated  a  reasonable  soul  and  a  sacred 
body,  to  which  the  Word  united  Himself  in 
hypostasis,  which  is  the  reason  of  its  being 
said,  '  He  was  born  according  to  the  flesh '  " 
(JDe  recta  Fide,  c.  56,  5,  &c. ;  Greg.  Naz. 
et  Cyril  in  Damasc.  de  Fide  Orthod.  iii.  6). 
Besides  letters  to  Nestorius,  St.  Cyril 
wrote  twelve  anathemas,  which  were 
adopted  by  the  third  general  council  at 
Ephesus.  With  these  anathemas  several 
passages  out  of  St.  Cyprian,  St.  Basil, 
Athanasius,  Gregory  Nazianzen,  and  many 
others,  were  read  in  the  council :  and 
from  them  they  gathered,  and  therefore 
pronounced,  that  according  to  the  Scriptures, 

2  L  2 


516 


MOTHER  CHURCH. 


as  interpreted  by  the  Catholic  Church,  Christ, 
though  He  liave  two  natures,  yet  He  is  but 
one  person,  and  by  consequence  that  the 
Virgin  Mary  might  properly  be  called 
GfOTOKor,  because  the  same  person  who  was 
born  of  her  is  truly  God  as  well  as  man  : 
which  being  once  determined  by  an 
univei'sal  council  to  be  the  true  sense  and 
meaning  of  the  Scriptures  in  this  point, 
hath  been  acknowledsed  by  the  universal 
Church  ever  since,  till  this  time. — Harduin, 
iii.  194. 

The  same  was  repeated  in  nearly  similar 
words  at  the  Council  of  Chalcedon  a.d.  451. 
The  term  is  not  used  frequently  by  Anglican 
divines,  probably  because  of  the  extreme 
into  which  the  Roman  Church  has  fallen 
with  regard  to  the  worship  of  the  Virgin. 
The  title  however  of  Georo/cof,  Deipara,  or 
Mother  of  God,  was  originally  adopted  not 
so  much  with  a  view  of  paying  honour  to 
the  Blessed  Virgin,  as  to  her  Divine  Son. 
— Soo.  H.  E.  vii.  32 ;  Hooker,  Ecc.  Pol.  v. 
52 ;  Hook's  Church  and  her  Ordinances,  ii. 
189 ;  Wilberforce,  Doct.  Incarn.  cvi.  p.  188. 
MOTHER  CHURCH  {Ecclesia  matrix). 
In  the  first  place  the  term  implied  a  Church 
immediately  planted  by  the  Apostles,  from 
which  other  Churches  were  afterwards  de- 
rived and  propagated.  It  is  thus  used  by 
Tertul  lian  (De  Prajscr'ipi.  c.  21),  and  in  this 
sense  Jerusalem  is  called  the  mother  of  all 
the  churches  in  the  world  {Epist.  Syn.  ad 
Damasc.  ap.  Theodor.  v.  9),  and  Aries  the 
mother  church  of  Gaul,  because  it  was 
supposed  to  have  been  planted  by  Trophi- 
miis,  first  bishop  of  that  place.  (2)  At  other 
times  the  mother  church  denoted  the  me- 
tropolis, or  the  principal  church  of  a  single 
province,  the  word  matrix  being  used  some- 
times for  the  primate's  see  (Cod.  Afric.  Can. 
119,  al.  120).  (3)  But  most  commonly  it  is 
used  to  signify  a  cathedral,  or  bishop's 
church;  that  which  requires  his  care  and 
residence,  as  being  (or  representing  if  the 
see  had  been  translated)  the  original  church 
and  continuing  to  be  the  principal  church  in 
his  diocese.  It  is  thus  used  in  several  canons, 
as  different  from  the  other  churches  in  the 
diocese.  T'hese  are  the  same  as  we  now  call 
parish  churches ;  but  they  used  very  fre- 
quently to  be  called  "  ecclesise  dioecesanas," 
diocesan  churches  (Suicer, s.v.  ixdrpi^;  Ponti- 
fic.  Vit.  MarcelW).  It  was  an  old  custom  in 
England  for  persons  to  make  offerings  at 
the  mother  or  cathedral  church  on  Mid- 
Lent  Sunday ;  hence  that  day  was  called 
Mothering  Sunday  (See  Mid-Lent). — 
Brand's  Antiq. ;  Bingham,  viii.  i.  12.  [H.] 
MOULDING.  An  ornamental  form 
given  to  angles  and  edges  of  masonry  or 
woodwork,  and  carried  uniformly  along  a 
considerable  extent.  The  use  of  mouldings 
must  commence  with  the  earliest  attempts 


MOURNERS 

at  ornament  in  masonry  or  carpentry.     The 
Saxon  mouldings,  so  tar  as  we  can  collect 
from  existing   specimens,  were    extremely 
rude   and   simple;    but  with   the   Norman 
mouldings  the  case  is  precisely  the  reverse, 
so  far,  at  least,  as  simplicity  is  concerned : 
for  though  the  mouldings  themselves  maj' 
be  lesolved  into  a  very  few  forms  and  com- 
binations, they  were  often  either  treated  as 
if  themselves  broken  and  united  together  at 
various  angles,  as  in  the  case  of  the  chevron 
and  embattled   mouldings;    or   they  were 
themselves  decorated  with  forms  not  of  their 
own   nature,  as  the   medallion,  beak  head, 
and  other  like  mouldings,  which  are,  how- 
ever,  strictly   speaking,  rather  decorations 
of  mouldings,  than  themselves    mouldings. 
It  would  far  exceed  our  limits  to  describe 
the  several  mouldings  of  the    succeeding 
styles.     We  must  be  content  with  saying, 
in  general,  that  in  the  Early  English  they 
reached  their  greatest  complexity  and  depili, 
and  that  they  gradually  became  less  nume 
rous,  and  shallower,  to  the  Perpendicular ; 
the  happy  mean  being  reached  in  this,  ab 
in  almost  everything  else,  in  the  Geometrical. 
The  particular  mouldings,  which  may  be 
said  to  be  distinctive  of  a  style,  are  chiefly 
the  ogee,  in   several  of  its   forms,   of  the 
Decorated ;    the    scroll  of   the   Decorated, 
with  the  later   Geometric ;  the  wide    and 
shallow  casement  or  hollow  of  the  Perpeii- 
dicular.     The  hollows,  in  the  Early  English, 
usually  separate   single  mouldings,  in  the 
Decorated  groups  of  mouldings.     1  he  earlii-r 
mouldings,  as  Norman  and  Early  English, 
generally  occupy  the  planes  of  the  wall  anl 
of  the  soffit;  the  later,  especially  Perpen- 
dicular, the  chamfer  plane  only.     To  be  fit 
all   appreciated,   the  subject  of  mouldini.;^ 
must  be  studied  in  the  Oxford  Glossary,  or 
in  Paley's  Manual  of   Gothic   Mouldings ; 
and  to   be  mastered,  it  must  be  pursued, 
pencil  in  hand,  in  our  ancient  ecclesiastical 
edifices.     [G.] 

MOURNERS;  MOURNING.  L  Tlie 
first  order  of  penitents,  or  candidates  of 
penance,  in  the  early  ages  of  the  Church 
were  called /erete  or  mourners.  They  lay 
prostrate  at  the  church  porch,  and  begged 
the  prayers  of  the  faithful  as  they  went  iu. 
After  a  time  their  petition  was  granted,  and 
they  were  admitted  among  the  audientes  or 
hearers. — Tertul.  de  Pxn.  c.  9 ;  St.  Basil, 
can.  22,  &c.  (See  Penitents). 

II.  (1)  From  the  earliest  days  of  the 
Church,  Christians  always  discouraged  any 
violent  and  extravagant  signs  of  grief,  as  it 
behoved  them  not  "  to  be  sorry  as  men 
without  hope."  Hence  it  was  enjoined  that 
psalms  should  be  sung  on  the  occasion  of  the 
death  of  a  believer  {Apost.  Const,  vi.  30),  for 
which  St.  Chrysostom  gives  the  reason, 
"  What  mean  our  hymns  ? "  he  asks ;  "  do 


MOVEABLE 

we  not  give  thanks  to  God  that  He  hath 
crowned  him  that  is  departed,  that  He  hath 
delivered  him  from  trouble  ?  "     (Horn.  4  in 
Hebr.).     And  the  same  Father  frequently 
dissuades  men  not  from  moderate  but  from 
excessive  grief,   as   iaconsistent  with   the 
psalmody    {Horn.   29   de    Dorm.).     When 
Lady  Paula  died,  St.  Jerome  says,  there  was 
"no  howling  or  lamenting,  as  used   to  be 
among  the  men  of  this  world,"  but  singing 
of  psalms     {Hier.  Eint.    Paulas,   Ep.  27). 
Yet  some  of  the  pagan  practices  crept  in,  for 
St.    Chrysostom,  in   another   place,  speaks 
against  mourners  beating  themselves  and 
lamenting;  and  he  also  refers  with  strong 
disapprobation  to  the  abuse  of  hiring  women 
to  act  as  mourners,  and  make  hideous  lamen- 
tations    {Horn.  32  in  Matt,  4  in  Hebr.,  6 
in  1  Thess.).     (2)  It  was  customary  to  have 
certain  days  of  mourning,  called  the  noven- 
diale,  being   the  third,  seventh,  and  ninth 
after  the  death,  to  which  others  were  added. 
Christian  reasons  for  these  days  are  given 
in  the  Apostolic  Constitutions  (viii.  42),  but 
St.  Augustine  speaks  against  the  custom  as 
of  heathen   origin   {Quaist.   172  in  Gen.). 
Reference,  however,  is  made  to  it  by  many 
later  writers,  and  at  the  present  day  it  is 
often  tlie  custom  to  observe  in  some  special 
way  the  anniversary  of   the   death   (Bing- 
ham, xxiii.  3).     (3)  Food  and  drink  were 
sometimes  supplied  to  the  mourners,  inso- 
much  that   scandal   was   caused   (Aug.  de 
Mor.    Ecd.   c.   34).      This   was  frequently 
condemned,  as  by  the  Council  of  Aries,  the 
Canons  of  Jsifric,  in  957,  and  by  Archbishop 
Thoresby  in  1367.    There  are  still,  however, 
vestiges  of  this  practice,  as  in  the  baked 
meats  and  burial  dinner  not  yet  extinct  in 
England.      (4)  Wearing  a  dark  or  "lugu- 
brious "  habit  as  sign  of  mourning,  was  not 
encouraged,  though  not  forbidden,  by   the 
early    Christians.       St.    Cyprian,    indeed, 
thought  no  mourning  at  all  ought   to  be 
shown  (de  Mortal,   p.    164) ;    St.   Jerome 
commends  a  rich  man  for  only  wearing  the 
mourning  habit  for  forty  days,  after  having 
lost  his   wife  and  two  daughters   {Hieron. 
Ep.  34,  ad  Jvlian.).     Such  mourning  (the 
clothes  themselves  taking   the  name  from 
custom)  and  other  "  trappings  of  woe,"  have 
always  been  more  or  less  used.      But  the 
burial  "  mutes,"  in  long  black  cloaks,  the 
hearse  with  its  plumes  of  black  horse-hair, 
&c.,  of  the  last  generation  are  passing  away, 
and  practices  taking  their  place  more  in  har- 
mony with  Christian  faith  and  hope.     [H.] 
MOVEABLE     AND     IMMOVEABLE 
FEASTS.    The  feasts  kept  in  the  Christian 
Church  are  called  moveable  and  immoveable, 
according  as  they  fall  always  on  the  same 
da,y  in   the  calendar   in  each  year,  as   the 
saints'  days ;   or  depend  on  other  circum- 
stances, as  Easter,  and  the  feasts  calculated 


MOZIAEABIC  LITURGY 


51T 


from  Easter.  The  Book  of  Common  Prayer 
contains  several  tables  for  calculating  Easter, 
and  the  following  rules  to  know  when  the 
moveable  feasts  and  holy-days  begin : 

"  Easter  day,  on  which  the  rest  depend, 
is  always  the  first  Sunday  after  the  full 
moon  which  happens  upon,  or  next  after,, 
the  twenty-first  day  of  March;  and  if  the 
full  moon  happens  upon  a  Sunday,  Easter 
Day  is  the  Sunday  after. 

"Advent  Sunday  is  always  the  nearest 
Sunday  to  the  feast  of  St.  Andrew,  Nov.  30,. 
whether  before  or  after. 


Septuageslma  1 
SexagesiTOa  I 
Quinquagesima  [ 
Quadragesima    ) 

Rogation  Sunday 
Ascension  Day 
W  hit-Sunday 
Trinity  Sunday 


Sunday  is 


{Nine 
Kigbt 
Seven 
Six 

IFive  Weelcs 
Forty  Days 
Seven  Weelts 
Kight  Weeks 


Weelcs  be  Tore 
Easter. 


After  Easter. 


Another  moveable  feast  is  Corpus  Christi, 
the  Thursday  after  Trinity  Sunday,  which 
consequently  does  not  appear  in  the  calen- 
dar, or  many  almanacks. 

MOYER'S  LECTURE.  A  lecture  es- 
tablished by  Lady  Moyer.  The  following 
is  an  extract  from  the  will  of  the  Lady 
Moyer,  or,  as  she  is  therein  styled,  "  Dame 
Rebecca  Moyer,  late  of  the  parish  of  St. 
Andrew,  Holborn,  in  the  county  of  Middle- 
sex, widow." 

"My  now  dwelling-house  in  Bedford 
Row,  or  Jockey  Field,  I  give  to  my  dear 
child  Eliza  Moyer,  that  out  of  it  may  be 
paid  twenty  guineas  a  year  to  an  able 
minister  of  God's  word,  to  preach  eight 
sermons  every  year  on  the  Trinity  and 
Divinity  of  our  ever-blessed  Saviour,  begin- 
ning with  the  first  Thursday  in  November, 
and  to  the  first  Thursday  in  the  seven 
sequel  months,  in  St.  Paul's,  if  permitted 
there,  or,  if  not,  elsewhere,  according  to  the 
discretion  of  my  executrix,  who  will  not 
think  it  any  encumbrance  to  her  house.  I 
am  sure  it  will  bring  a  blessing  on  it,  if 
that  work  be  well  and  carefully  carried  on, 
which  in  this  profligate  age  is  so  neglected. 
If  my  said  daughter  should  leave  no  children 
alive  at  her  death,  or  they  should  die  before 
they  come  to  age,  then  I  give  my  said  house 
to  my  niece,  Lydia  Moyer,  now  wife  to 
Peter  Hartop,  Esq.,  and  to  her  heirs  after 
her,  she  always  providing  for  that  sermon, 
as  I  have  begun  twenty  guineas  every  year." 
The  lectures  have  ceased,  as  there  is  no 
compulsory  obligation  in  the  will  to  per- 
petuate the  lecture,  the  probability  is  that 
the  property  fell  into  other  hands.  Dr. 
Morell,  about  1775,  was  the  last  lecturer. 

MOZ  ARABIC  LITURGY.  The  ancient 
liturgy  of  Spain.  The  word  is  derived  from 
Estarab,  to  Arabize;  participle  Moztarab  or 
Mozatab,  one  who  has  adopted  the  Arab 
mode   of  life :  hence  the   name   Mozarabic 


518 


MOZECTA 


signified  those  Christians  who  were  mixed 
with,  or  lived  in  the  midst  of,  Arabs,  or 
Moors.  Mr.  Palmer  considers  that  this 
liturgy  was  derived  at  a  very  early  a^e  from 
that  of  Gaul,  which  it  much  resembles.  It 
was  abolished  in  1060  in  Arragon,  but  was 
not  for  some  time  afterwards  relinquished 
in  Navarre,  Castile  and  Leon.  In  1074, 
Sancho  III.  of  Navarre  introduced  the 
Eoman  order,  to  the  regret  of  the  people. 
Cardinal  Ximenes,  at  the  beginning  of  the 
16th  century,  founded  a  college  and  chapel 
in  Toledo  for  the  celebration  of  this  rite : 
the  only  place  perhaps  in  Spain  where  it  is 
preserved.- — Palmer's  Origin.  Liturg.  i.  166. 

MOZECTA,  MUZECTA,  MOZZETTA. 
An  ecclesiastical  vestment  or  short  cape 
like  the  bishop's  colobrium  or  tunicle,  worn 
by  the  canons  in  certain  cathedrals  of  Sicily. 
— Peiri  Sicilia  Sacra. 

MULLION,  more  con-ectly  Monial.  The 
upright  bars  dividing  a  traceried  window 
into  lights. 

MUSIC,  CHURCH.  Whether  we  study 
the  forms  of  worship  adopted  by  ancient 
Pagan  nations,  or  confine  our  attention  to 
those  of  the  Israelites  of  old,  we  shall  per- 
ceive that  in  every  case  music  formed  an 
important  integral  part  of  them.  This  is 
not  the  place  to  discuss  the  music  so  em- 
ployed by  heathen  nations ;  it  will  suffice 
to  refer  those  who  are  curious  in  such 
matters  to  the  admirable  article  on  the 
word  "  Musioa "  by  the  late  Professor 
Donkin,  in  Smith's  "  Dictionary  of  Greek 
and  Roman  Antiquities,"  or  to  the  His- 
tories of  Music  by  Dr.  Burney  and  Sir 
J.  Hawkins,  or  to  Wilkinson's  "Ancient 
Egyptians,"  where  all  that  is  known  on  the 
subject  is  fully  set  forth.  Neither  will  it 
be  necessary  to  say  much  on  the  music 
of  the  Jewish  people  as  recorded  in  the 
Bible,  for  in  truth  very  little  is  certainly 
known  about  it.  Dr.  Stainer  has  collected 
all  that  can  be  gathered  concerning  the 
musical  instruments  of  the  Bible  in  a  very 
excellent  little  treatise  of  his  on  that 
subject ;  while  some  useful  remarks  are  to 
be  found  on  the  musical  rendering  of  the 
Psalms  in  the  Temple  in  Dr.  Jebb's  learned 
work,  "A  Literal  Translation  of  the  Psalms," 
also  in  Smith's  "  Dictionary  of  the  Bible." 
All  that  need  be  said  in  this  place  on  those 
subjects  is  that  the  musical  system  and 
scales  of  the  various  nations  differed  then 
as  much  as  they  do  still  in  the  countries  of 
the  Bast.  Some  had  scales  consisting  of 
smaller  intervals  than  we  now  recognise, 
while  others  adopted  the  pentatonic  scale. 
No  universal  agreement  existed  then  on 
these  elementary  points,  and  consequently 
what  was  music  to  one  nation  was  mere 
jargon  to  another.  Such  was  unquestion- 
ably the  condition  of  the  art  of  music  at 


MUSIC 

the  time  of  our  Lord,  and  for  some  centuries 
afterwards  in  Europe.  It  is  probable  there- 
fore that  when  the  Christian  Church  was 
founded,  the  disciples  of  different  nation- 
alities praised  God  each  after  their  own 
fashion,  the  converts  from  Judaism  singing 
Christian  hymns  to  Jewish  melodies,  while 
the  Greeks  and  Romans  adapted  to  sacred 
words  the  tunes  which  had  previously 
adorned  the  ritual  of  the  old  heathen 
temples.  Traces  of  this  variety  of  system 
still  exist  in  the  Church-music  of  Greece, 
and  of  Asiatic  Christians.  In  Western 
Christendom,  however,  it  was  not  long  be- 
fore attempts  were  made  to  bring  all  this  con- 
fusion into  some  sort  of  order  and  uniformity, 
though  it  took  centuries  to  bring  so  gigantic 
an  undertaking  to  anything  like  perfection. 
The  earliest  reformer  of  the  music  of  the 
Church  was  St.  Ambrose  (bom  in  340,  con- 
secrated bishop  of  Milan  in  374,  and  died 
in  397).  He  regulated  the  chanting  of  the 
Psalms  according  to  the  system  of  the  tetra- 
chords,  and  adopted  Greek  melodies  also  for 
the  Hymns  of  the  Church.  From  what  is 
related  of  his  system  by  Odo  of  Cluny  and 
others,  it  appears  certain  that  the  Ambrosian 
music  retained  a  good  deal  of  the  chromatic 
and  even  enharmonic  ornamentation  which 
was  peculiar  to  Greek  music,  involving  a 
multitude  of  turns  and  grace-notes,  and  the 
use  of  small  intervals,  more  or  less  at  variance 
with  the  solemnity  proper  to  ecclesiastical 
art.  Moreover,  it  does  not  appear  that  the 
musical  reforms  inaugurated  by  St.  Ambrose 
ever  extended  far  beyond  the  limits  of  his 
own  diocese  of  Milan ;  so  that  however 
great  the  improvements  introduced  by  him 
may  have  been,  they  cannot  have  exercised 
any  very  wide  or  abiding  influence  on  the 
Christian  Church  at  large.  That  they  were 
great  improvements,  however,  is  amply 
vouched  for  by  the  testimony  of  St.  Augus- 
tine, who  refers  to  the  effects  produced  on 
him  by  the  music  of  the  Church  at  the 
time  of  his  conversion  to  the  faith  by  the 
preaching  of  St.  Ambrose,  and  who  was  him- 
self the  author  of  a  treatise  on  music  which 
is  still  extant.  St.  Ambrose  is  credited  with 
the  composition  of  the  great  hymn,  "Te 
Deum  Laudamus."  But  whether  the  music 
is  trulj'  attributable  to  him  as  well  as  the 
words,  has  never  been  certainly  ascertained. 
St.  Gregory  the  Great,  who  was  born  in 
542,  was  chosen  Pope  in  590,  and  died  in 
604,  carried  out  a  very  complete  reformation 
and  reorganisation  of  the  music  of  the 
Church,  the  good  effects  of  which  were  felt 
throughout  Western  Christendom.  Very 
little  is  known  about  the  melodies  select- 
ed or  composed  by  St.  Gregory  in  his 
famous  Antiphonary.  The  so-called  Gre- 
gorian melodies  were  for  the  most  part 
composed  at  a  subsequent  period ;  but  there 


MUSIC 

are  two  facts  the  truth  of  which  is  un- 
douhted — First,  that  he  systematised  the 
tonality  of  the  Plainsong  of  the  Chui-ch, 
by  adopting  that  arrangement  of  the  ancient 
Greek  tetracliords  which  produces  eight 
scales  or  modes,  of  which  the  1st,  3rd,  5th, 
and  7th  are  named  Authentic,  and  the 
others  are  derived  from  them  and  named 
PJagal.  The  four  Authentic  modes  were 
named  Dorian,  Phrygian,  Lydian  and  Mixo- 
lydian,  while  the  Plagal  modes,  being  four 
notes  lower  in  pitch  than  the  corresponding 
Authentic  modes,  were  named  Hypodorian, 
Hypophrygian,  Hypolydian,  and  Hypomixo- 
lydian.  These  scales  or  modes  may  be 
represented  in  modern  garb  as  follows  : — 

1.  Dorian      .     .     .     .    3,  c,  f,  g,  a,  b,  c,  d. 

2.  Hypodorian    .    u,  b,  c,  ^,  e,  f,  g,  a. 

3.  Phrygian e,  f,  g,  a,  b,  c,  d,  e. 

4.  Hjijophrygian     .  b,  c,  d,  e,  f,  g,  a,  b. 

5.  Lydian f,  g,  a,  b,  c,  d,  c,  f. 

6.  Hypolydian  .      c,  d,  e,  f,  g,  a,  b,  c. 

7.  Mixolydian g,  a,  b,  c,  d,  e,  f,  g. 

8.  Hypomixolydiau      .     d,  e,  f,  g,  a,  b,  c,  d. 

Every  ecclesiastical  melody  used  in  the 
Western  Church  before  the  sixteenth  cen- 
tury was  composed  in  some  one  of  these 
scales  or  modes.  Secondly,  St.  Gregory  sim- 
plified the  Chm'ch  music  by  getting  rid  of 
Oriental  ornaments  and  subdivisions  of  in- 
tervals which  had  been  imported  into  the 
Ambrosian  system.  Indeed  it  is  probable 
that  in  the  original  Gregorian  Antiphonary 
every  note  was  of  equal  value,  whatever 
syllable  it  was  set  to.  But  if  so,  this  anti- 
prosodiacal  method  was  soon  modified  so 
as  to  suit  the  length  and  accent  of  the 
syllables.  By  the  zeal  and  authority  with 
which  the  musical  system  of  St.  Gregory 
was  propagated,  it  soon  became  the  general 
usage  of  every  branch  of  the  Western 
Church,  albeit  in  certain  countries  some 
discrepancies  long  continued  to  exist.  It 
must  here  be  borne  in  mind  that  there 
was  in  all  this  no  question  of  Harmony. 
Although  certain  rude  forms  of  Harmony 
were  no  doubt  practised  by  the  northern 
nations  of  Europe  in  the  days  of  St.  Gregory, 
yet  they  were  entirely  unknown  to  him  and 
his  contemporaries.  Hence  the  difficulty 
which  must  ever  be  found  in  adopting 
barmonies  to  most  of  the  Gregorian  melodies. 
In  fact  it  cannot  be  done  without  not  onl}^ 
being  guilty  of  gross  anachronism,  but  also 
destroying  in  a  great  measure  the  distinctive 
characteristics  of  the  various  ancient  scales 
or  modes.  Another  noticeable  feature  in 
these  old  melodies  is  the  entire  absence  of 
metrical  symmetry,  or  rhythm,  save  what 
belongs  to  the  words  to  which  they  are  set. 
As  time  went  on,  two  musical  systems  were 
growing  up  side  by  side.  There  was  the 
Church  music,  unrhythmical  and  purely 
melodic,    and    there    was    secular    music, 


MUSIC 


519 


necessarily  rhythmical  when  employed  for 
dances  or  marches,  and  often  rudely  har- 
monised, especially  in  the  northern  parts 
of  Europe.  Gradually  an  amalgamation 
took  place  of  these  contrariant  systems, 
much  to  the  advantage  of  the  art.  The 
earlier  attempts  of  monastic  theorists  to 
mtroduce  harmony  were  most  crude.  The 
long  consecutions  of  fifths,  fourths,  and 
octaves,  which  were  practised  before  the 
latter  half  of  the  fourteenth  century,  would 
be  utterly  intolerable  to  a  modern  ear ;  but 
after  this  period  the  harmony  of  the  Church 
by  degrees  became  more  like  what  we  are 
wont  to  call  by  that  name  in  these  days. 
For  examples  of  early  attempts  at  harmony, 
the  reader  is  referred  to  the  admirable 
publications  of  De  Coussemaker.  The  two 
men  who  did  most  to  advance  the  know- 
ledge and  practice  of  music  during  this 
period,  were  Guido  d'  Arezzo  (about  990  to 
1040),  by  his  admirable  method  of  training 
singers  ;  and  Franco  of  Cologne  (about  1020 
to  1090),  the  inventor  of  a  system  of 
musical  notation  whereby  the  different 
lengths  of  notes  were  distinguished,  who 
may  therefore  be  called  the  father  of 
mensurable  music.  By  the  invention  of 
mensurable  music  the  way  was  opened  to 
the  introduction  of  Descant,  which  soon  was 
develojjed  into  double  counterpoint,  canon, 
and  fugue.  But  at  length  harmonised 
hymns  of  a  strictly  metrical  kind  were  in- 
troduced, at  first  by  the  unreformed,  but 
afterwards  by  the  reformed  Churches,  and 
became  after  the  spread  of  the  Reformation 
the  prevalent  music  of  the  Protestants. 
These  also  owed  their  origin  in  a  great 
measure  to  the  invention  of  mensurable 
music,  and  in  their  turn  exercised  a  vast 
infiuence  on  ecclesiastical  art. 

We  see,  then,  that  at  the  time  of  the 
Reformation  in  England  there  were  two 
kinds  of  Church  music.  One,  strictly 
ecclesiastical  in  character,  founded  on  the  Gre- 
gorian scales  and  melodies,  and  in  a  contra- 
puntal and  complicated  style  of  composition. 
The  other  plain  and  simple,  metrical  in  struc- 
ture, derived  mainly  from  the  sacred  songs  of 
the  Lollards  at  home  and  the  Protestants 
abroad.  When  the  Liturgy  was  translated 
into  English,  the  liturgical  music  had  to  be 
adapted  to  the  change.  And  this  was  no 
easy  task.  But  it  was  accomplished  by  the 
combined  skill  of  such  men  as  Marbecke, 
Tye,  Tallis,  Byrd,  and  Morley.  By  the 
end  of  Queen  Elizabeth's  reign  the  Church 
of  England  was  furnished  with  as  fine  a 
repertory  of  chants,  services,  and  anthems 
as  could  be  found  in  any  Christian  country 
in  the  world.  But  that  was  not  enough, 
for  the  puritanical  section  of  the  Church 
disliked  the  cathedral  style  of  music,  and 
clamoured  for  leave  to  sing  metrical  Psalms 


520 


MUSIC 


and  Hymns.  This  was  granted  by  an  In- 
junction of  Queen  Elizabetli,  -whereby  it 
was  allowed  to  sing  metrical  Psalms  and 
hymns  before  and  after  any  Church  ser- 
vice. In  1562,  for  the  first  time,  a  metrical 
rendering  of  the  whole  Psalter  with  musical 
notes  was  printed,  and  tacUed  on  to  the 
Book  of  Common  Prayer.  Its  title  was  as 
foUows :  "  The  whole  Booke  of  Psalmes 
collected  into  English  Metre  by  T.  Stern- 
hold,  J.  Hopkins,  and  others,  conferred  with 
the  Ebrue,  with  apt  notes  to  sing  them 
withaL  Imprinted  by  John  Day."  In  this 
publication  only  the  melody  was  printed, 
but  in  Wi  9  William  Damon  added  four-part 
harmonies  to  the  tunes;  of  which  another 
edition  appeared  in  1591.  But  it  was  not 
tin  1594  that  a  really  adequate  setting  of 
the  metrical  Psalms  in  harmony  was  brought 
out.  This  excellent  work  was  published  by 
T.  Est.  and  the  composers  engaged  in  har- 
monising it  were  John  Dowland,  E.  Blanks, 
E.  Hooper,  J.  Parmer,  E.  Allison,  G.  Kirbye, 
W.  Cobbold,  E.  Johnson,  and  G.  Farnaby. 
In  fact  these  were  some  of  the  best  com- 
posers of  anthems,  services,  part-songs  and 
madrigals  then  alive.  They  put  the  melody 
in  the  tenor  part,  according  to  the  prevalent 
custom  at  that  period,  while  the  other  parts 
sung  accompanying  harmonies. 

Not  to  mention  some  other  publications 
of  Psalm-tunes  of  less  importance,  we  must 
next  refer  to  an  admirable  collection  brought 
out  in  1621  and  ItiSS  by  Thomas  Eavens- 
crol't,  Mus.  Bac,  which  contains  many  tunes, 
still  in  use,  of  the  very  best  kind,  and  ex- 
cellently harmonised  by  the  best  musicians 
of  the  period.  It  would  be  impossible,  in 
such  an  article  as  the  present,  to  describe 
the  many  collections  of  tunes  which  were 
subsequently  brought  out.  But  it  may 
suffice  to  mention  the  books  of  "Wither, 
Playford,  and  the  version  by  Brady -and 
Tate,  as  samples. 

Before  the  Eeformation,  England  could 
scarcely  have  been  said  to  possess  a 
national  style  of  Church  music  at  all. 
Ecclesiastical  compositions  were  then  all  set 
to  Latin  words,  and  based  upon  Gregorian 
melodies,  which  formed  the  "  Cantus 
finnus,"  round  which  counterpoints  or 
descants  w-ere  built.  Such,  as  we  have 
already  seen,  was  the  case  throughout 
Western  Christendom,  and  a  wonderful  uni- 
formity of  style  consequently  prevailed. 
The  very  few  specimens  of  English  sacred 
music  which  have  come  down  to  us  from 
those  early  times  are  very  like  the  composi- 
tions of  the  old  Elemish  school,  of  which 
the  celebrated  Jusquiu  des  Pr6s  was  the 
chief.  But  the  Enghsh  Church  composers 
were  decidedly  inferior  to  their  continental 
contemporaries,  both  in  conception  and  in 
workmanship.     But  the  Eeformation  had 


MUSIC 

begun  to  exercise  no  inconsiderable  influence 
on  the  arts,  and  especially  on  music,  even 
at  the  beginning  of  the  sixteenth  century. 
The  increasing  prevalence  of  metrical 
Psalmody  tended  to  introduce  an  apprecia- 
tion of  rhythm  and  symmetry  in  music 
which  did  not  exist  before,  and  thus  a  great 
deal  of  crudeness  of  accent  and  want 
of  metrical  balance  was  happily,  though 
gradually,  got  rid  of.  The  translation  of 
the  services  of  the  Church  into  the  ver- 
nacular also  exercised  no  small  influence 
in  natiouahsing,  as  it  were,  the  style  of  our 
ecclesiastical  music.  It  was  not  long  after 
this  that  the  immortal  Palestrina  saved  the 
figurate  music  of  the  Eoman  Church  from 
extinction,  which  was  threatened  by  the 
Council  of  Trent,  in  consequence  of  the 
abuses  which  had  crept  into  it  through 
the  contrapuntal  extravagancies  and  secu- 
larities  of  the  Flemish  composers  and  their 
Italian  disciples.  Palestrina  composed  four 
Masses  in  which  true  sublimity  was  so  art- 
fully combiued  with  contrapuntal  ingenuit5r, 
and  freshness  of  invention  with  strict 
adherence  to  ancient  precedents,  that  his 
music  was  accepted  by  the  Council,  and  the 
doom  of  sacred  art  was  averted.  Palestrina 
became  the  originator  and  propagator  of  a 
new  and  excellent  school  of  vocal  music 
both  sacred  and  madrigalesque,  which  for 
many  years  formed  the  model  followed  by 
subsequent  masters.  There  can  be  no  doubt 
that  Enghsh  art  was  vastly  improved  by 
the  influence  of  this  new  Eomau  school, 
and  thus  it  came  to  pass  that  during  the 
reign  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  both  in  Cathedral 
music  and  in  the  composition  of  secular 
madrigals,  Enaland  could  successfully  vie 
with  all  the  other  nations  of  the  woild. 
The  names  of  Tye,  Marbecke,  Tallis,  and 
Byrd  deserve  to  be  wiitten  in  golden  letters, 
as  having  done  for  English  sacred  art  what 
Palestrina  did  for  that  of  Eome ;  and  it  is 
at  this  point  that  the  history  of  our  Cathe- 
dral music  properly  begins.  The  eariiest 
document,  to  which  reference  can  be  made, 
which  exhibits  a  setting  of  any  portion  of 
the  service  in  English  to  music,  is  the 
Litany  of  1544,  said  (with  every  proba- 
bility) to  have  been  adapted  by  Archbishop 
Cranmer  himself.  The  next  document  is 
the  "Prayer-book  Noted"  by  Marbecke  in 
1549.  Both  these  are  unisonal  notations. 
Probably  the  earliest  hannonised  Litany  is 
that  to  be  found  in  John  Day's  services, 
published  in  1560,  and  afterwards  in  1565. 
We  must  also  mention  the  services  set  by 
Caustun,  Heath,  and  others,  to  be  foimd 
also  in  Day's  book.  This  brings  us  down 
to  the  famous  Thomas  Tallis,  who  may  be 
regarded  as  the  Father  of  English  Cathedral 
music.  It  was  he  who  first  harmonised  the 
Eesponses and Precesof  Morning  and  Evening 


MUSIC 

Prayer.     English  Cathedral  music  by  that 
time  had  assumed  pretty  nearly  the  form 
which  it  still  maintains.     It  will  he  well, 
therefore,  to  describe  that  form  before  pro- 
ceeding to  other  branches  of  our  subject.    It 
will  be  ihe  most  convenient  jilan  to  divide 
English  Choral  service  music  into  four  distinct 
divisions.     Each  of  these  is  made  use  of  in 
its  proper  place.     It  is  this  variety  of  kind 
which  renders  a  fully  choral  rendering  of  the 
service  so  valuable  an  aid  to  devotion  as  all 
find  it  to  be  who  have  accustomed  them- 
selves to  its  use.     Of  these  four  divisions, 
the  first  and  simplest  consists  of  the  plain 
monotone,  and  of  the  unrhj^thmical  versiole 
and  response.     Here  we  have  true  recitative 
of  the  best  kind.     It  has  also  the  merit  of 
extreme  antiquity,  being  an  English  adapta- 
tion  of  the  traditional   inflexions    of   the 
Western  Church  in  mediaeval  times.     It  is 
partly  sung  by  the  officiating  minister,  and 
partly  by  the  choir  and  congregation.    Their 
portion  is   usually,   though   by  no  means 
necessarily,  harmonised.     But,  in  any  case, 
it  is  desirable  that  the  general  congrtgation 
should  sing  only  the  I'lainsong  or  melody, 
leavmg  the  harmonies  to  be  supplied  by  the 
choir.     On  festival  occasions,   the  ora;an  is 
used  to  accompany  the  responses,  and  then 
Tallis's  incomparable  harmonies  should  al- 
ways be  employed.     On  other  occasions  it 
is  usual  to  adopt  other  and  simpler   har- 
monies, and  these  vary  in  difl'erent  dioceses. 
None,  however,  should  be  tolerated  which 
do    not    retain   the    old   Plaiusong   in  its 
integrity,  either  in  the  soprano  or  in  the 
tenor  part.     The  portions   of  the   services 
in  wljich  this  kind  of  music  is  employed 
are  the  Preces,  Versicles,  and  Ilesponses  at 
Morning  and  Evening  Prayer ;  the  Litany ; 
and   the   Sursum  Corda  in  the   ofiice   for 
Holy  Communion ;   to  which  may  be  added, 
occasionally,  such  Versicles  and  Eesponses 
as    occur    in   the    Maixiage    and    Funeral 
services    and    similar    offices.       The  next 
division  is  the  Psalm-chant.     This  so  far 
agrees  with  the  first  division   as   to  have 
an   unrhythmical   element ;   but   it  differs 
from  it  in  all  else.     English  chants  are  of 
two  kinds,  single  and  double.     A  single 
chant  is    sung  to   a  single   verse  of    the 
Psalms  or  Canticles,  and  repeated  without 
alteration  for  every  succeeding   verse.      A 
double   chant  takes   in   two   verses.      But 
only  a  certain  number  of  the  Psalms  are 
really  suitable  for  a  double  chant,  because 
it  often   happens   that  a  new  sentence  or 
sentiment  begins  at  one  of  the  even  verses, 
which  would  necessarily  have  to  be  sung  to 
the  latter  half  of  a  double  chant,  so  that 
the  beginning  of  the  sentence   would  not 
correspond  to  that  of  the  music ;  moreover, 
if  a  Psalm  or  Canticle  has  an  odd  number 
of  verses,  the  only  way  to  adapt  a  double 


MUSIC 


521 


chant  to  it  is  to  rexicat  the  latter  part  of  the 
chant  for  the  concluding  verse,  which  is 
truly  a  most  clumsy  and  inartistic  con- 
trivance. Single  chants  are,  obviously,  free 
from  this  awkwardness,  and  can  be  sung  to 
an}"-  Psalm  or  Canticle  without  interfering 
with  the  sense  of  the  words.  Every  single 
chant  consists  of  seven  bars  of  music,  and 
is  divided  into  two  portions  by  a  double 
bar.  These  portions  are  of  unequal  length, 
consisting  respectively  of  three  or  four  bars. 
1'he  double  bar  corresponds  with  the  colon 
placed  in  the  middle  of  every  verse  in  the 
Prayer-book  Psalter.  The  fij-st  note  in  each 
portion  is  either  a  seraibreve,  or  (more 
rarely)  a  dotted  minim  followed  lay  a 
crotchet.  On  these  initial  notes  is  recited 
so  much  of  the  words  of  the  verse  as  cannot 
be  assigned  to  the  remaining  bars.  Accord- 
ingly, these  "reciting  notes,"  as  they  are 
called,  are  of  indeterminate  length,  and  are 
always  supjwsed  to  have  a  pause  over  them. 
The  words  so  recited  should  be  uttered 
distinctly  and  deliberately,  minding  all  the 
necessary  stops  and  accents,  after  the 
ordinary  fashion  of  good  reading.  The  last 
two  bars  of  the  former  and  the  last  three 
bars  of  the  latter  portion  of  the  chant 
should  bo  sung  in  strict  time,  and  at  such  a 
pace,  that  the  syllables  may  follow  each  other, 
on  an  average,  at  about  the  same  speed  as 
in  the  unrhythmical  or  recitative  bars. 

It  is  usual  to  divide  a  choir  into  two 
bands,  one  on  the  south  and  the  other  on 
the  north  side  of  the  chancel.  These  bands, 
or  semichoruses,  are  severally  named  "De- 
cani "  and  "  Cantoris,"  after  the  Dean  and 
Precentor  of  a  cathedral.  It  is  customary 
to  chant  the  verses  of  the  Psalms  alternately, 
or  antiphonally,  the  two  bands  answering 
one  another  verse  by  verse,  and  all  uniting 
for  the  Gloria  Patri. 

In  some  modern  choirs  an  attempt  is  occa- 
sionally made  to  adapt  the  old  Gregorian 
Psalm-chants  to  our  English  Psalter.  Some- 
times they  are  sung  in  unison,  with  free  organ 
accompaniment;  sometimes  they  are  har- 
monised vocally.  The  objection  to  the 
former  plan  is  that  it  opens  the  door  to 
very  incorrect  and  licentious  hannonisalions 
on  the  part  of  inexperienced  organists.  The- 
objection  to  the  latter  plan  is  that  it  over- 
throws the  chief  advantages  claimed  for  the 
use  of  these  obsolete  melodies,  viz.  easiness 
of  execution,  and  conformity  to  primitive 
practice.  The  objections  to  both  alike  are 
that,  in  the  first  place,  the  Gregorian  scales 
in  which  these  old  tunes  are  written  are 
for  the  most  part  very  ill  adapted  to 
harmony ;  in  the  next  place,  that  to  har- 
monise theni  at  all  involves  a  gross  ana- 
chronism ;  and  in  the  last  place,  that  they 
are  very  unsuited  to  the  genius  and  accent 
of  the  English  language. 


.522 


MUSIC 


We  come  now  to  speak  of  the  third 
clivision  of  Choral  music  for  the  Church. 
This  has  only  one  featm-e  in  common  with 
the  English  Psalm-chant,  and  tliat  is  its 
.antiphonal  arrangement.  It  is  a  kind  of 
music,  employed  mostly  in  cathedrals  and 
■college  chapels,  for  the  Canticles  and  Hymns 
of  the  Prayei-  Book,  i.e.  the  Te  Deum, 
Benedictus,  Jubilate,  Magnificat,  Cantate 
Domino,  Nunc  Dimittis,  and  Dens  Misere- 
.atur ;  and  also  for  the  Kyrie,  Nicene  Creed, 
Sanctus,  and  Gloria  in  Excelsis,  in  the 
Office  for  the  Holy  Communion.  Such 
■compositions  are  technically  called  "  Cathe- 
dral Services."  A  service,  in  this  restricted 
sense,  means  a  series  of  elaborate  settings 
of  the  above  Canticles  and  Hymns,  generally 
in  the  same  key  throughout.  Hence  we 
speak  of-  Rogers'  Service  in  D,  or  Gibbons' 
in  F,  and  so  forth.  -  These  settings  are 
often  of  value  as  music,  and  very  edifying 
TO  musicians,  and  to  all  who  are  accustomed 
to  their  use,  but  they  are  by  no  means 
■congregational  in  character ;  it  is  therefore 
perhaps  undesirable  to  adopt  them  in  or- 
dinary parish  churches,  except  on  rare  and 
festal  occasions.  But  in  all  cathedral  and 
■collegiate  churches,  and  perhaps  in  the 
principal  churches  of  our  largest  towns, 
they  are  assuredly  most  appropriate.  In 
ordinary  churches  it  is  customary  and 
desirable  to  sing  the  Canticles  to  Psalm- 
chants,  and  the  Bucbaristio  Hymns  either 
in  monotone  or  to  some  easy  unisonal 
•setting  such  as  that  of  old  Marbecke,  whose 
music,  for  the  Nicene  Creed  especially,  is 
sublime.  Some  of  the  finest  etforts  of  our 
best  English  composers  have  been  the 
•elaboration  of  Cathedral  services.  In  the 
best  of  these,  the  music  is  of  a  more  or  less 
descriptive  kind,  and  there  is  also  ample 
scope  for  examples  of  counterpoint  and 
fugue,  not  to  mention  various  artistic  effects 
produced  by  the  alternated  or  combined 
use  of  the  organ  and  the  voices,  or  by  the 
Introduction  ot  passages  sung  in  unison,  or 
by  short  portions  assigned  to  single  voices, 
or  to  duets,  trios,  or  quartettes,  commonly 
•called  "verses" ;  by  all  which  means  great 
variety,  contrast,  and  expression  may  be 
secured. 

The  fourth  division  of  choral  music  in 
church,  which  is  the  Anthem,  is  (artistically 
speaking)  the  highest  of  all.  It  differs  from 
the  rest  mainly  in  that  it  is  not  intended  to 
be  congregational.  It  .should  be  regarded 
rather  as  a  kind  of  vocal  interlude  or  choral 
-voluntary,  adapted  to  rest  the  mind  of  the 
listening  worshipper,  and  thus  prepare  it 
for  fresh  acts  of  devotion.  Anthems  are 
set  to  any  suitable  words  of  Holy  Scripture, 
■or  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer.  They 
may  be  meditative,  jubilant,  or  penitential 
in  character ;  they  may  be  sung  entirely  in 


MYSTERY 

chorus,  in  which  case  they  are  called  "  Full 
Anthems,"  or  they  may  contain  certain 
portions  to  be  sung  as  duos,  trios,  or 
quartettes,  in  which  case  they  are  desig- 
nated "  Verse  Anthems,"  or  they  may  be 
written  for  one  single  Toice  with  organ 
accompaniment,  with  perloaps  a  few  bars  of 
chorus  to  conclude,  in  which  case  they  are 
termed  "  Solo  Anthems."  When  anthems 
are  used  in  ordinary  cimrches  full  anthems 
are  most  advantageously  adopted.  In  well- 
endowed  choirs,  including  good  soloists, 
verse  and  solo  anthems  are  also  admissible 
and  suitable,  provided  they  do  not  lead  to 
personal  display.  In  most  small  parish 
churches,  however,  it  is  customary  to  sub- 
stitute for  the  anthem  a  metrical  hymn. 

It  will  not  be  out  of  place  here  to  give  a 
list  of  the  chief  composers  of  Church  music 
in  England,  with  their  dates  : — 

Bora  atjout  Died 

Cliristopher  Tye,  Mus.  Doc.  .     .        1520  .  .  1580 

Jolin  Marbeclce 1523  .  .  ]5S5 

Tliomas  Tallis 1529  .  .  1585 

■\Villiam  Byrd 1539  .  .  1623 

John  Bull,  Mus.  Doc 1563  .  162S 

Thomas  Morley,  Mus.  Bac.    .     .     .  1563  1604  ; 

Orlando  Gibbons,  Mus.  Bac.  .          .  1583  .  .  1625 

William  Child,  Mus.  Doc.      .     .     .  1605  .  1696 

Benjamin  Rogers,  Mus.  Doc. .     .     .  1614  .  .  1691 

Robert  Creyghton,  D.D.          .     .     .  1639  .  .  1736 

Henry  Aldri.b,  D.D 1647  .  .  1710 

John  Blow,  Mus.  Doc 1648  .  1708 

Henry  Purcell 1658  .  .  1695 

Jeremiah  Clark 1608  .  .  1707 

William  Croft,  Mus.  Doc.      .     ,     ,  1677  .  .  1727 

Maurice  Greene,  Mus.  Doc.   .     .     .  1693  .  .  1755 

William  Boyce,  Mus.  Doc.     .     .     .  1710  ,  .  1778 

Samuel  Arnold,  Mus.  Doc.     .     .     .  1739  .  .  1802 

Samuel  Wesley 1766  .  .  1337 

Thomas  Attwood 1767  .  .  1838 

William  Crotch,  Mos.  Doc.    .     .     .1775  .  .  1847 

Sir  John  Goss,  Mus.  Doc.       .     .     .  1800  .  .  1880 

Samuel  Sebastian  AVesley,  Mus.  Doc.  1810  .  .  1876 

Sir  G.  A.  Macfarrcn.M.A.,  Mus.Doc.  1813  .  .  . 

Henry  Smart 1813  ,  .  1879 

Sir  Herbert  S.  Oakeley,  M.A.,  Mus. 

Doc 1830  .  

John  Stalner,  M.A.,  Mus.  Doc.  .     .  1840  .  .  

Sir  Arthur  S.  Sullivan,  Mus.  Doc.  .  1842  .  .  

[F.A.G.O.] 

To  this  hst  must  be  added  last,  though 
not  least,  the  name  of  Sir  Frederic  A.  Gore 
Ouseley,  Mus.  Doc,  M.A.,  LL.D.,  Professor 
of  Music  in  the  University  of  Oxford. 

MUSIC  TABLE.  A  sort  of  Lectern, 
with  three  sides,  round  which  the  choir 
were  placed,  in  the  middle  of  Bishop  Au- 
drewe's  chapel ;  as  appears  by  the  plan  given 
in  Canterhurys  Doom,  1646. 

MYNCHEKY.  A  nunnery.  A  corrup- 
tion of  ministere,  or  minster. 

MYSTERIES  (See  Moralities).    " 

MYSTERY  (From  ^l.wlv  to  o-ro/xa,  to 
shut  the  mouth :  hence  (ivarriptov,  mystery). 
Something  secret,  hidden  from  human  com- 
prehension, or  revealed  only  in  part.  The 
term  is  applied  both  to  doctrines  and  facts. 
By  the  usage  of  the  Church  it  also  denotes 
that  inscrutable  union  in  the  sacraments  of 
the  inward  and   spiritual  grace  with  the 


MYSTIC 

outward  and  visible  sign.  Hence  in  the 
«arly  Churcli  tlie  sacraments  were  denomi- 
nated "  mysteries,"  and  tlie  term  derived  a 
still  greater  force,  from  the  secrecy  which 
was  observed  in  the  administration  of  those 
ordinances.  More  especially,  however,  was 
the  Holy  Communion  thus  designated,  as  we 
learn  from  the  ancient  Fathers,  who  speali 
repeatedly  of  the  "  sacred  "  and  "  tremendous 
mysteries,"  in  allusion  to  this  sacrament. 
With  this  application,  the  term  appears  in 
our  own  Communion  Office,  where  Christ 
is  said  to  have  "  instituted  and  ordained 
holy  mysteries,  as  pledges  of  His  love,  and 
for  a  continual  remembrance  of  His  death." 
We  are  also  exhorted  so  to  prepare  ourselves, 
that  we  may  be  "  meet  partakers  of  those 
holy  mysteries ; "  and  after  their  reception, 
thanis  are  rendered  to  God,  that  He  has 
vouchsafed  to  "  feed  us  who  have  duly 
received  these  holy  mysteries,  with  the 
spiritual  food  of  the  most  precious  body 
and  blood  of  His  Son,  our  Saviour,  Jesus 
Christ." 

MYSTIC.     Sacredly  obscure. 

MYSTIC  RECITATION.  Several  parts 
of  the  Greek  liturgy  are  ordered  to  be  said 
ifi-va-rucas,  that  is,  in  a  low  voice,  or  whisper, 
like  the  secreto  of  the  Roman  offices. — Jehb. 

MYSTICAL.  Having  a  hidden,  alle- 
gorical, 'or  secret  meaning.  In  the  bap- 
tismal offices  we  read,  "  Sanctify  this  water 
to  the  mystical  washing  away  of  sin  :  "  from 
which  it  would  be  absurd  to  infer  that  the 
mere  physical  application  of  water  can 
remove  sin ;  and  yet,  on  the  other  hand, 
the  fact  that  the  remission  of  sin  is  associated 
■svith  baptism,  rests  on  Scriptural  authority. 
There  is,  therefore,  a  secret  operation  of 
Ood's  grace  in  cleansing  the  soul  linked  to 
the  sacramental  application  of  water  to  the 
body;  and  the  concurrence  or  co-existence 
of  these  the  Church  regards  as  a  "  mystical 
washing  away  of  sin." 

Again :  in  the  Communion  Office,  the 
faithful  recipients  are  said  to  be  "  veiy 
[true]  members  incorporate  of  the  mystical 
body  of  Christ."  Now,  how  the  Church  cau 
•constitute  "  the  body  of  Christ,"  will  appear 
to  any  one  an  inscrutable  mystery,  if  he 
■will  but  divest  himself  of  the  familiarity  of 
the  terms.  As  to  the  fact,  it  is  indisputable ; 
but  the  manner  is  beyond  our  full  compre- 
hension, partaking  in  some  measure  of  the 
nature  of  allegory,  and  being  strictly  mystical. 
It  is  worth  while  to  add,  that  the  Church 
does  not  recognise  the  notion  of  an  invisible 
Church,  as  constituting  this  "mystical 
body,"  composed  of  those  only  who  shall 
he  finally  saved ;  for  she  goes  on  to  pray 
for  the  assistance  of  God's  grace,  "  that  we 
may  continue  in  that  holy  fellowship,"  &c., 
a  petition  somewhat  irrelevant  if  such  an 
hypothesis  be  adopted. 


MYSTICS 


523 


MYSTICS.  A  party  which  arose  towards 
the  close  of  the  third  century,  distinguished 
by  their  professing  pure,  sublime,  and  per- 
fect devotion.  They  excuse  their  fanatical 
ecstasies  by  alleging  the  passage  of  St  Paul, 
"The  Spirit  prays  in  us  with  sighs  and 
groans  which  cannot  be  uttered."  They 
contend  that,  if  the  Spirit  prays  within  us, 
we  must  resign  ourselves  to  its  motions,  and 
be  guided  and  swaj'ed  through  its  impulse 
by  remaining  in  a  state  of  mere  inaction. 
The  principles  proceeded  from  the  known 
doctrine  of  the  Platonic  school,  which  was 
also  adopted  by  Origen  and  his  disciples, 
that  the  Divine  nature  was  diffused  through 
all  human  souls;  or  that  the  faculty  of 
reason,  from  which  proceed  the  health  and 
vigour  of  the  mind,  was  an  emanation  from 
God  into  the  human  soul,  and  comprehended 
in  it  the  principles  and  elements  of  all  truth, 
human  and  divine.  They  denied  that  men 
could,  by  labourer  study,  excite  this  celestial 
flame  in  their  breasts;  and  therefore  they 
disapproved  highly  of  the  attempts  of  those 
who,  by  definitions,  abstract  theoi'ems,  and 
profound  speculations,  endeavoured  to  form 
distinct  notions  of  truth,  and  to  discover  its 
hidden  nature.  On  the  contrary,  they  main- 
tained that  silence,  tranquillity,  repose,  and 
solitude,  accompanied  with  such  acts  as 
might  tend  to  extenuate  and  exhaust  the 
body,  were  the  means  by  which  the  hidden 
and  internal  word  was  excited  to  produce 
its  latent  virtues,  and  to  instruct  them  in 
the  knowledge  of  Divine  things.  For  thus 
they  reasoned :  Those  who  behold  with  a 
noble  contempt  all  human  affairs  ;  who  turn 
away  their  eyes  from  terrestrial  vanities, 
and  shut  all  the  avenues  of  the  outward 
senses  against  the  contagious  influences  of 
a  material  world,  must  necessarily  return  to 
God  when  the  spirit  is  thus  disengaged  from 
the  impediments  that  prevented  that  happy 
union ;  and  in  this  blessed  frame  they  not 
only  enjoy  inexpressible  raptures  from  their 
communion  mth  the  Supreme  Being,  but  are 
also  invested  with  the  inestimable  privilege 
of  contemplating  truth  undisguised  and  un- 
corrupted  in  its  native  purity,  while  others 
behold  it  in  a  vitiated  and  delusive  form. 

The  number  of  the  Mystics  increased  in 
the  fourth  century,  under  the  influence  of 
the  Grecian  fanatic,  who  gave  himself  out 
for  Dionysius  the  Areopagite,  disciple  of 
St.  Paul,  and  probably  lived  about  this 
period ;  and  by  pretending  to  higher  degrees 
of  perfection  than  other  Christians,  and 
practising  greater  austerity,  their  cause 
gained  ground,  especially  in  the  Eastern 
provinces,  in  the  fifth  century.  A  copy  of 
the  pretended  works  of  Dionysius  was  sent 
by  Balbus  to  Louis  the  Meek,  in  the  year 
824,  which  kindled  the  holy  flame  of  mysti- 
cism in  the  Western  provinces,   and  filled 


524 


N.  OR  M. 


tlie  Latins  with  the  most  enthusiastic  admi- 
ration of  this  new  reUgion.  In  the  twelfth 
century,  these  Mystics  tooli  the  lead  in  their 
method  of  expoundiog  the  Scriptures.  In 
the  thirteenth  century  they  were  the  most 
formidahle  antagonists  of  the  Schoolmen ; 
nnd,  towards  the  close  of  the  fourteenth, 
many  of  them  resided  and  propagated  their 
tenets  in  almost  every  part  of  Europe. 

Among  the  Mystics  of  that  time  we  may 
notice  the  Dominican  John  Tauler,  of  Stras- 
hurg,  A.D.  1361,  to  whom  ma}'  he  attributed 
the  paternity  of  mysticism,  in  its  modern 
foi-m ;  Henry  Suso  of  Ulm,  A.D.  1305  ;  and 
especially  John  Ruyshroeck,  called  Doctor 
Ecstaticus,  a.d.  1381,  who  of  all  the  Mystics 
was  the  most  dreamy  and  enthusiastic. 
Among  Protestants  there  have  been  and  ai'e 
many  Mystics,  hut  they  have  not  formed  a 
sect. — Gieseler;  Stuhbs'  Mosheim,  i.  157; 
ii.  212  ;  iii.  92. 


N. 

N.  OE  M.  Letters  in  the  place  of  the 
name  of  the  child  in  the  Catechism  :  in  the 
office  of  Baptism  "  N  "  only  occurs.  Pro- 
bably these  letters  stood  for  Nomen  vel 
Nomina — N.  vel  NN.,  the  latter  being  after- 
wards corrupted  by  the  printers  into  M.    [H.] 

NAG'S  HEAD  FABLE.  This  was  a 
false  and  absurd  invention  of  theEomanists, 
to  invalidate  the  orders  of  the  Church  of 
England,  by  pretending  that  Ahp.  Parker 
had  never  been  duly  consecrated  a  bishop. 
Even  if  he  was  not,  it  would  not  invalidate 
the  consecrations  in  which  he  took  part 
afterwards,  inasmuch  as  he  was  alwaj'S  only 
one  of  several  conseorators,  according  to  the 
practice  of  the  Church  in  all  ages,  which  so 
precludes  the  possibility  of  any  failure  in 
the  succession,  as  transmission  by  a  single 
bishop  has  been  always,  held  sufficient, 
though  more  concur  ex  ahundanti.  The 
Popish  story  was  that  Parker  was  conse- 
crated at  the  Nag's  Head  Tavern  in 
Cheapside  by  only  one  bishop,  of  several 
who  were  present,  v.'ho  laid  the  Bible  on 
Dr.  Parker's  head,  and  then  pronounced  the 
words,  "'lake  thou  auttiority,"  &c.  It  is 
further  objected,  that  three  of  the  four 
bishops  then  present  were  only  bishops 
elect,  and  had  no  sees ;  and  that  the  other 
was  a  suffragan. 

The  story  further  is,  that  the  queen  issued 
forth  her  warrant,  directed  to  the  Bishop  of 
Llandaff;  to  Dr.  Scory,  elect  of  Hereford; 
Dr.  Barlow,  elect  of  Chichester ;  Dr.  Cover- 
dale,  elect  of  Exeter  ;  and  Dr.  Hodgkins,  suf- 
fragan of  Bedford;  and  that  all  these  persons 
met  at  the  Nag's  Head  1'avern,  where  it 
had  been  usual  for  the  Dean  of  the  Arches  and 


NAME 

the  civilians  to  refresh  themselves,  after  any 
confirmation  of  abishop ;  and  thereooe  Nealc, 
who  was  Bonner's  chaplain,  peeped  through 
a  hole  in  the  door,  and  saw  all  the  other 
bishops  very  importunate  with  Llandaflf,  who 
had  been  dissuaded  by  Bonner  to  assist  in 
this  consecration,  which  he  obstinately  re- 
fusins.  Dr.  Scory  bid  the  rest  to  kneel,  and 
he  laid  the  Bible  on  each  of  their  shoulders 
or  heads  and  pronounced  these  words,  "  Take 
thou  authority,"  &c.,  and  so  they  stood  up 
all  bishops.  This  story  was  certainly  in- 
vented after  the  queen's  reign ;  for  if  it  had 
been  true,  it  is  so  remarkable  that  some  of 
the  writers  of  that  time  would  undoubtedly 
have  taken  notice  of  it.  No  sooner  was  it 
put  forth  than  a  living  witness  of  Parker's 
consecration  came  forward  to  contradict  it, 
in  a  sermon  at  Paul's  Cross,  March  17, 1560- 
(Le  Bus' JeiueJ,  91).  Moreover  Bishop  Burnet 
has  discovered  the  falsity  of  the  story  from 
an  original  manuscript  of  the  consecration 
of  this  very  archbishop,  which  was  done  in 
the  chapel  at  Lambeth,  on  Sunday,  the  17th 
of  December,  in  the  first  year  of  the  queen's 
reign,  where  Dr.  Parker  came  a  little  after 
five  in  the  morning  in  a  scarlet  gown  and 
hood,  attended  by  the  said  four  bishops,  who 
had  been  duly  consecrated ;  and  there,  after 
prayers.  Dr.  tScory  preached ;  and  then  the 
other  bishops  presented  the  archbishop  to 
him,  and  the  mandate  for  his  consecration 
being  read  by  a  doctor  of  the  civil  law,  and 
he  having  taken  the  oaths  of  supremacy,  and 
some  prayers  being  said,  according  to  the- 
form  of  consecration  then  lately  published, 
all  thfti^ur  bishops  laid  their  hands  on  the 
arcliD^op^  head,  and  said,  "  Receive  the 
Holy  Ghost?'  &c.  And  this  was  done  in  the 
presence  of  several  other  clergy. — Lingard, 
Jlist.  of  Enrjland,  vol.  vii.,  note  G ;  Burnet's- 
Hist,  of  Reform,  ii.  808  ;  Koo^s  Arclibishops, 
ix.  250,  where  Dr.  Lingard's  refutation  of 
the  fable,  addressed  to  the  Birmingham  B.  0. 
Magazine,  1834,  is  given  in  extenso.     [H.] 

NAHUM,  THE  PROPHECY  OP.  A. 
canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament. 
Nahum  is  the  seventh  of  the  twelve  lesser 
prophets;  a  native  of  Elkoshai,  a  little 
village  of  Galilee,  the  ruins  of  which  were 
still  to  be  seen  in  the  time  of  St.  Jerome. 
The  particular  circumstances  of  this  pro- 
phet's life  are  unknown. 

Authors  are  divided  as  to  the  time  when 
Nahum  prophesied,  some  fixing  it  to  tlie 
name  of  Abaz,  others  to  that  of  Manasseh, 
and  others  to  tlie  times  of  the  captivity. 
St.  Jerome  places  it  in  the  reign  of  Hezekiah, 
after  the  war  of  Sennacherib  in  Egypt, 
which  the  prophet  speaks  of  as  a  thing 
passed  (See  Speaker's  Comm.;  Milman's 
Hist,  of  Jews,  i.  369). 

NAME.  I.  The  Name  of  the  Lord  was 
known  to  the  Jews  under  four  forms,  (1)  EL, 


NAME 

the  strong  one,  7t<,  a  word  which  in  poetic 
language  frequently  stands  without  any 
adjunct,  sometimes  with  the  article  7^<^  (Ps. 
xviii.  31,  &o. ;  Job  viii.  3),  and  sometimes 
with  the  suffix  of  the  first  person  yi^,  "  my 
God !  "  (Ps.  xviii.  3  :  xxii.  11,  &c.).  But 
in  prose  the  word  is  scarcely  ever  applied  to 
God  without  some  adjunct  or  attribute,  as 

(2)  EL  SHADDAI,  ''•^P  "pfc!,  God  Almighty 
(Gen.  xvii.  1 ;  Ex.  vi.  2,  3,  &c.),  sometimes 
without  the  hv{,  EL,  (Job  v.  17 ;  Ruth  i.  20, 
&c.);  (3)  JEHOVAH,  the  self-existent 
(translated  in  the  LXX  as  Kvpios) ;  (4) 
JEHOVAH  SABAOTH,  the  Lord  of  Hosts 
(See  Jehovah,  Sahaoth).  In  the  name  of  the 
Lord  the  prophets  were  commissioned  to 
preach,  the  priests  to  bless  ;  therefore  to 
prophesy  in  the  name  of  the  Lord  implied 
direct  communication  ^vith  Him,  and  su- 
preme authority  for  the  words  spoken 
(Deut.  xviii.  22).  Our  Blessed  Lord  uses 
the  same  form  of  expression  in  reference  to 
His  own  mission  ;  speaking  of  the  works 
that  He  did  "  in  His  Father's  Name " 
(St.  John  X.  25).  And  then  having  taught 
the  disciples  that  "  I  and  My  Father  are 
one,"  He  told  them  that  they  should  do 
mighty  works  "  in  My  Name "  (St.  Mark 
xvi.  18)  ;  with  full  faith  in  which  promise 
St.  Peter  said  to  the  lame  man  at  the  gate 
of  the  temple,  "  In  the  name  of  Jesus  Christ, 
rise  up  and  walk"  (Acts  iii.  6).  In  the 
Christian  Church  the  formula  is  extended, 
and  the  Apostles  and  their  successors  re- 
ceive their  commission  in  the  name  of  the 
Father,  the  Son,  and  the  Holy  Ghost. 
These  words  are  used  only  in  the  most 
solemn  offices,  as  at  Baptism,  Absolution  of 
the  Sick,  Ordering  of  Deacons  and  Priests, 
and  Consecration  of  Bishops. 

11.  The  Christian  name  is  given  us  in 
baptism.  As  it  is  given  as  a  badge  that  we 
belong  to  Christ,  we  cannot  more  properly 
take  it  upon  us  than  when  we  are  enlisted 
under  His  banner.  We  bring  one  name 
into  the  world  with  us  which  we  derive  from 
our  narents,  and  which  serves  to  remind  us 
of  nar  original  guilt,  and  that  we  are  bom  in 
sin :  but  this  new  name  is  given  us  at  our 
baptism,  to  remind  us  of  our  new  birth, 
when  being  washed  in  the  laver  of  regene- 
ration, we  are  thereby  cleansed  from  our 
natural  impurities,  and  become  in  a  man- 
ner new  creatures,  and  solemnly  dedicate 
ourselves  to  God.  It  was  the  custom  until 
1552,  according  to  ancient  practice,  for  the 
bishop  to  confirm  the  children  by  name; 
and  sometimes  the  baptismal  name  was  then 
altered.  In  such  a  case,  according  to  Lord 
Coke,  the  name  of  the  confirmation  would 
stand  good. — Case  of  Sir  Francis  Gardie, 
Coke's  Inst.  i.    iii. ;    Johnson's  Canon,  ii. 


NATIVITY 


525 


277 ;  Wheatly,  334 ;  Annot.  P.  B.  ii.  258 
(See  Christian  Name).     [H.] 

NANTES,  EDICT  OF.  An  edict  of 
toleration,  promulgated  by  Henry  IV.  of 
Fiance  in  1598,  which  restored  the  Pro- 
testants to  all  the  favours  which  had  been 
granted  them  in  former  reigns,  and  gave 
them  the  liberty  of  serving  God  according 
to  their  conscience,  and  a  full  participation 
in  all  civil  rights  and  privileges.  This 
edict  was,  at  the  instigation  of  the  Jesuits, 
revoked  by  Louis  XIV.  in  the  year  1686. 

NAETHEX  {Gr.  and  Lat).  This  name 
is  given  by  ancient  writers  to  the  vestibule 
of  a  church.  There  was  the  exterior  or 
outward,  and  the  interior  or  inward,  Narthex. 

The  exterior  narthex,  which  we  may  call 
the  ante-temple,  consisted  of  the  whole 
circumference  of  the  outward  courts,  in- 
cluding the  vestibulum  or  porch,  and  the 
atrium  or  area  before  the  church.  Of  a 
narthex  in  this  large  sense,  the  church  of 
St.  Ambrogio  at  Milan  supplies  a  very  fine 
example. 

The  interior  narthex,  or  ante-temple 
within  the  church  (the  only  part  properl}^ 
so  called),  was  the  tirst  section  or  division 
of  the  I'abric,  after  entering  into  the 
church,  and  was  peculiarly  allotted  to  the 
women,  and  used  for  the  offices  of  ro- 
gations, supplications,  and  night-watches. 
Here  likewise  they  placed  the  corpses  whilst 
the  funeral  rites  were  being  performed. 
This  lower  part  of  the  church  was  the 
place  of  the  Energumens  and  the  Audi- 
etites  ;  and  hither  Jews,  heathens,  heretics, 
and  schismatics  were  sometimes  allowed  to 
come,  in  hopes  of  their  conversion  by  hearing 
the  Scriptures  read  and  sermons  preached. 

Dr.  Beveridge  and  others  seem  to  place 
here  the  foot  or  baptistery,  as  in  our  mo- 
dern churches.  But  it  is  certain  that,  for 
many  ages,  the  baptistery  was  a  distinct 
place  from  the  body  of  the  chcurh,  and 
reckoned  among  the  Exedr^,  or  buildings 
adjoining  to  the  church.  This  part  of  the 
church  was  called  Nartliex,  because  being 
long,  but  narrow,  and  running  across  the 
front  of  the  church,  it  was  supposed  to 
resemble  a,  ferula,  that  is,  a  rod  or  staff; 
for  any  oblong  figure  was  by  the  Greeks 
called  vapdr]^,  Narthex.  Another  derivation 
connects  the  word  with  vepdev.  If  so,  it  is 
rather  of  the  nature  of  what  is, called  a 
Slype  in  several  cathedrals,  which  is  gene- 
rally connected  with  the  south  transept. 

NATIONAL  COVENANT  (See  Con- 
fessions of  Faith). 

NATIONAL  SOCIETY  (See  Societies, 
Church). 

NATIVITY  OP  OUE  LORD  (See 
Christmas  Bay). 

NATIVITY  OF  ST.  JOHN  THE  BAP- 
TIST (See  John,  St.,  Baptist's  Day): 


526 


NATIVITY 


NATIVITY  OP  THE  BLESSED  VIR- 
GIN :  commemorated  Sept.  8.  The  insti- 
tution of  this  festival  has  been  ascribed 
to  Pope  Servius  a.d.  695.  Concerning 
the  Blessed  Virgin's  parentage  nothing 
is  said  beyond  that  she  was  of  the  house 
and  lineage  of  David.  Tradition  gives 
Joachim  and  Anne  as  her  father  and  mother 
(See  Anne,  St.).     [H.] 

NAVE.  That  part  of  the  church  which 
extends  from  the  west  end  to  the  transept 
or  choir.  The  derivation  of  this  word  has 
been  a  matter  of  dispute.  Some  derive  it 
from  vdos,  a  temple;  others  from  navis 
(vavs),  a  ship,  since  the  nave  resembles 
the  hull  of  a  ship  turned  upside  down  ;  and 
refer  both  this  term  and  vaos  also  to  the 
ancient  Phoenicians,  whose  original  temples 
were  said  to  be  their  vessels  thus  reversed. 
At  all  events  it  is  remarkable  that  both  the 
old  French  nef,  the  Italian  and  Spanish  nave, 
and  the  Latin  navis,  all  signify  a  ship  as 
well  as  the  nave  of  a  church. 

The  internal  length  of  the  nave  in  a  cross 
church  is  properly  measured  from  the  face 
of  the  west  wall  near  the  window  to  the 
eastern  face  of  the  western  wall  of  the  tower, 
which  corresponds  with  the  internal  west 
face  of  the  transepts  if  they  have  no  western 
aisles.  The  external  length  of  a  nave  is 
fairly  reckoned  from  the  west  face  of  the 
west  buttresses  to  the  outside  of  the  tower. 
The  enormous  porches  of  Peterborough,  be- 
ing as  high  as  the  nave  itself,  must  be 
reckoned  in  the  external  length,  and  make 
it  about  260  feet,  which  is  only  exceeded  by 
Winchester,  about  275,  and  St.  Alban's,  which 
is  a  little  over  300,  and  the  longest  Gothic 
nave  io  the  world.  The  west  Galilee  at  Ely 
can  hardly  be  reckoned  as  part  of  the  nave, 
being  low  and  really  only  a  porch,  and  the 
length  would  not  come  up  to  St.  Alban's  if 
it  were.  For  the  internal  lengths,  see  "  Book 
on  Building."  No  foreign  naves,  except  St. 
Peter's  and  St.  Paul's  at  Eome,  Bologna  and 
Milan,  approach  those  of  our  long  cathedrals. 
But  many  of  them  exceed  ours  both  in 
height  and  width  considerably,  having  often 
five  aisles,  i.e.  two  on  each  side  of  the  middle 
or  nave  proper.  Chichester  is  our  only  five- 
aisled  cathedral  nave,  but  a  few  churches 
have  them,  such  as  St.  Michael's  Coven- 
try, and  Kendal.  Boston  and  Yarmouth 
churches,  though  79  and  110  feet  wide, 
have  only  three  divisions,  and  they  have  a 
bad  effect.  Yarmouth  is  the  widest  in  the 
kingdom,  and  after  that  York  Minster, 
where  everything  is  on  the  largest  scale,  and 
so  it  does  not  look  too  wide.  The  height  of 
our  cathedral  naves  is  generally  very  nearly 
the  same  as  the  entire  width,  and  twice  the 
height  of  the  aisles,  of  which  the  width  is 
generally  half  that  of  the  middle.  West- 
minster   alone    is    much    higher  than  its 


NAZARENES 

width,  and  three  times  its  middle  widths 
while  all  the  others  are  from  two  to  two 
and  a  half  at  the  most.     [G.] 

NAVICULA;  sliip,  or  arh.  A  vessel 
formed  "like  the  keel  of  a  boat,"  out  of 
which  the  frankincense  was  poured  in 
Bishop  Andrewes'  chapel,  and  Queen  Eliza- 
beth's chapel. — Canterbury's  Doom,  1646. 
See  Hierurgia  Anglicana,  pp.  4,  5,  and  9. 

NAVY,  ROYAL,  Church  work  in.  Of 
60,000  seamen  and  marines,  75  per  cent, 
belong  to  the  Church  of  England.  For  these  . 
there  are  100  chaplains,  the  head  of  whom 
is  called  the  Chaplain  of  the  Fleet,  who  is 
responsible  for  the  selection  of  the  clergy, 
and  for  all  spiritual  supervision,  except,  of 
course,  unless  he  is  also  a  bishop,  ordination 
and  confirmation.  The  latter  is  claimed  from 
and  performed  by  the  several  bishops  in 
the  diocese  where  the  candidates  happen  to 
he.  Of  the  chaplains,  half  serve  in  sea-going 
ships,  and  of  the  rest  some  are  in  harbour 
establishments  abroad.  On  board  every 
shijj  in  commission,  whether  carrying  a 
chaplain  or  not,  the  Admiralty  instructions 
direct  that  Divine  seiwice  shall  take  place 
daily;  the  service  is  laid  do-svn  in  the 
authorized  Watch  Bill,  and  the  church 
pennant  is  hoisted  at  the  peak  during  its 
continuance.  The  week-day  prayers  con- 
sist of  selections  from  the  Liturgy,  includ- 
the  prayers  to  be  used  at  sea.  On  Sundays 
there  is  regular  church  in  the  forenoon, 
attended  by  all  hands  that  have  no  "  con- 
scientious scruples."  If  there  is  no  chaplain 
the  captain  conducts  the  service. — Official 
Year  Book  of  the  Church  of  England,  1883— 
1886.     [H.] 

NAZARENES.  I.  A  name  originally 
given  by  the  Jews  to  all  Christians  in 
general,  because  Jesus  Christ  was  of  the 
city  of  Nazareth  (Acts  xxiv.  5).  II.  After- 
wards the  name  was  applied  to  a  sect  of 
heretics,  who  affected  to  assume  it  rather 
than  that  of  Christians.  Their  rehgion  was 
a  strange  jumble  of  Judaism  and  Chris- 
tianity :  for  they  were  Jews  by  birth,  were 
circumcised,  kept  the  Sabbath,  and  other 
observances  of  the  Mosaical  law;  and  at 
the  same  time  received  the  New  Testament 
as  well  as  the  Old,  acknowledged  Jesus 
Christ  to  be  the  Messiah,  and  practised  the 
Christian  baptism  (De  Emr.  fab.  ii.  2). 
Theodoret,  indeed,  pretends  they  honoured 
Jesus  Christ  only  as  a  just  and  good  man ; 
and  he  places  the  beginning  of  their  heresy 
about  the  time  of  Domitian.  St.  Augustme 
makes  them  the  successors  of  those  whose 
obstinacy  in  the  like  opinions  was  con- 
demned by  the  apostolical  Council  of  Jeru- 
salem (August,  de  JEser.  ix. :  Contra  Faust. 
xix.  4  :  Ep.  ad  Hieron.  Ixxxii.). 

The  Nazarenes  (as  well  as  the  Ebionites)' 
were  descended  fi-om  those  Christians,  who 


NECROLOGY 

left  Jerusalem  a  little  before  the  siege,  and 
retired  to  tlie  country  about  Jordan,  called 
Perea;  whence  they  are  sometimes  called 
Peratics.  There  were  some  of  them  remain- 
ing in  the  time  of  St.  Augustine.  They 
dwelt  about  Pella  in  Deoapolis,  near  the 
river  Jordan,  and  at  Berea,  a  city  of  Lower 
Syria.  They  perfectly  understood  the 
Hebrew  or  Aramaic  tongue,  in  which  they 
read  the  books  of  the  Old  Testament. 

These  heretics,  keeping  the  mean  between 
the  Jews  and  the  Christians,  pretended  to 
be  friends  alike  to  both :  nevertheless,  the 
Christians  treated  them  as  heretics,  and  the 
Jews  detested  them  more  than  the  other 
Christians,  because  they  acknowledged  Jesus 
Christ  to  be  the  Messiah.  Epiphanius 
(JHseres.  xxix.)  says,  they  cursed  and  ana- 
thematized them  three  times  a  day  in  their 
synagogues. — Burton's  Sect.  Eccl.  Hist.  350 ; 
Lardner's  Credibility,  &c.,  ii.  363. 

NBCROLOaY.  A  book  in  which,  after 
the  diptychs  fell  into  disuse,  in  cathedral 
and  collegiate  churches  and  minsters,  the 
names  of  the  departed  connected  with  them 
were  entered.  Probably  the  name  was  read 
out  once  a  year  on  the  anniversary  of  death, 
hence  Bede  speaks  of  the  "year  book." 
The  Benedictines  adopted  necrologies  at 
the  beginning  of  the  sixth  century. — Wal- 
cott's  Sac.  Arch.  896  ;  Diet,  of  Christ.  Ant. 
1382.     [H.] 

NEHEMIAH,  THE  BOOK:  OP.  A 
canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament.  Ne- 
hemiah  was  born  at  Babylon  during  the 
captivity,  and  succeeded  Ezra  in  the  go- 
vernment of  Judah  and  Jerusalem  ;  whither 
he  came  with  a  commission  from  Artaxerxes 
Longimanus,  authoiizing  him  to  repair  and 
fortify  the  city  in  the  same  manner  as  it 
was  before  its  destruction  by  the  Baby- 
lonians. He  died  at  Jerusalem,  having 
governed  the  people  of  Judah  for  about 
thirty  years. — Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible. 

NEOLOGIANS.  German  Rationalists 
are  so  designated ;  from  vios,  new,  and  \6yos, 
doctrine.  They  are  distinguished  from 
mere  deists  and  pantheists  by  admitting 
the  principal  facts  of  the  Bible,  though  they 
attempt  to  explain  away  what  is  miraculous, 
while  they  treat  the  Scriptures  with  no 
more  of  reverence  than  they  would  show  to 
any  other  ancient  book,  and  regard  our 
Lord  Himself  as  they  would  regard  any  good 
and  wise  philosopher  (See  Rationalism). 

NEOPHYTE  (>/€o0uros— newly  planted). 
I.  A  person  newly  baptized ;  that  is,  newly 
engrafted  on  Christ.  The  neophytes  wore 
white  robes  in  token  of  their  being  cleansed 
from  sin,  and  the  Sunday  after  Easter  was 
one  of  the  days  on  which  they  put  off  those 
garments,  and  hence  it  was  called  Dominica 
in  Albis.  St  Augustine  thus  explains  the 
custom  :  "  Paschalis  solemnitas  hodierna  fes- 


NIOOLAITANS 


527- 


tivitate  concluditur,  et  ideo  hodie  neophy- 
torum  habitus  commutatur;  ita  tamen,  ut 
candor,  qui  de  habitu  deponitur,  semper  in 
corde  teneatur  "  {Horn.  Ixxxvi.).  II.  A  clerk 
or  novice  promoted  to  a  bishopric  without 
proceeding  through  the  inferior  orders.  This 
was  frequently  forbidden  (1  Tim.  iii.  6 ; 
Apost.  Can.  80 ;  Cone.  Laod.  c.  3,  &c.).    [H.] 

NESTORIANS  (See  Mother  of  Ood). 
The  followers  of  Nestorius,  bishop  of  Con- 
stantinople, who  lived  in  the  fifth  century. 
They  believed  that  in  Christ  there  were  not 
only  two  natures,  but  two  persons;  of  which, 
the  one  was  Divine,  even  the  Eternal  Word, 
and  the  other,  which  was  human,  was  the 
man  Jesus ;  that  these  two  persons  had  only 
one  aspect ;  that  the  union  between  the  Son 
of  God  and  the  Son  of  man  was  formed  in. 
the  moment  of  the  Virgin's  conception,  and 
was  never  to  be  dissolved ;  that  it  was  not,, 
however,  an  union  of  nature  or  of  person, 
but  only  of  will  and  affection;  that  Christ 
was  therefore  to  be  carefully  distinguished 
from  God,  who  dwelt  in  Him  as  in  His 
temple ;  and  that  Mary  was  to  be  called  the- 
mother  of  Christ — ;(pioT-oTOKor —and  not 
the  mother  of  God — deoTOKos. 

This  heresy  was  condemned  by  the  fourth 
general  council,  that  of  Ephesus,  a.d.  431 ; 
in  which  all  are  anathematized  who  refuse- 
to  call  the  Virgin  Mary  the  mother  of  God 
(See  Badger's  Nestorians  and  their  Rituals). 

NEW  STYLE.  In  1752  an  Act  "for 
regulatingthe  commencement  of  the  year,and 
correcting  the  Calendar  "  was  passed.  From 
this  the  present  tables  of  the  Prayer  Book 
were  printed,  not  from  the  Sealed  Books. 
They  are  incorrect  for  finding  Easter  before- 
1753.  The  year  was  made  to  begin  with 
January  1  instead  of  March  25,  as  in  the 
"Old  Style."  The  "New  Style"  was  first 
introduced  by  Gregory  XIII.  in  1582,  but 
not  adopted  in  England  till  24  George  II. 
(See  Calendar).     [H.] 

NEW  TESTAMENT  (See  Testament). 

NEW  YEAR'S  DAY.  The  1st  of  Jan- 
uary was  not  originally  connected  with  the 
opening  of  the  Christian  year:  indeed,  it 
was  not  "  New  Year's  Day  "  till  the  year 
1752  (See  New  Style).  On  this  day,  being 
the  eighth  day  after  Christmas,  is  the  festi- 
val of  the  "  Circumcision  of  Christ "  (See 
Circumcision).     [H.] 

NEWEL.  The  central  column  round, 
which  the  steps  of  a  circular  staircase  wind. 
It  is  a  part  of  each  step.  A  large  circular 
staircase  like  that  in  St.  Paiil's  has  no- 
newel.  Tliey  are  sometimes  designed  with 
considerable  taste,  and  carefully  executed. 

NICENB  CREED  (See  Creed). 

NICOLAITANS.  Heretics  who  arose  in 
the  Christian  Church  during  the  time  of  the 
apostles,  as  appears  from  Rev.  ii.  6,  15., 
Some  of  the  ancient  fathers  affirm  that 


528 


NICOLAS,  ST. 


Nicolas,  one  of  the  seven  first  deacons,  was 
the  founder  of  this  sect;  and  that  his 
followers  led  lives  of  unrestrained  indul- 
gence (Iren.  cont.  Reeves,  i.  26).  Clement 
of  Alexandria,  however,  asserts  that  there  is 
no  reason  for  thinking  Nicolas  to  have 
been  given  to  immoralities  {Strom,  iii.  4). 
That  there  was  a  sect  of  this  name  is  certain, 
but  from  whom  or  what  that  name  is  de- 
rived, or  whether  they  taught  the  same  doc- 
trines with  the  Gnostics  is  a  matter  of  qi^es- 
tion  (cf.  Tertixll,  de  praiscript.  c.  46  ;  Euseb. 
II.  E.  iii.  29  ;  Theod.  Hair.  fab.  iii.  c.  1). 

NICOLAS,  ST. .  Bishop  and  Confessor  : 
commemorated  Dec.  6.  He  was  a  native  of 
Patara,  in  Asia  Minor ;  bishop  of  Myra  in 
Lycia ;  died  a.d.  342.  His  remains  were  re- 
moved from  Myra  to  Bari  ou  the  Adriatic  by 
some  merchants  in  1087,  for  fear  they  should 
be  desecrated  by  the  Mohammedans.  Hence 
St.  Nicolas  has  been  accounted  the  patron 
of  merchants  and  seafaring  men.  He  is  also 
the  patron  saint  of  Russia.     [H.] 

NICOMEDE,  ST.  Supposed  to  have 
been  a  disciple  and  fellow-labourer  of  St. 
Peter.  Refusing  to  sacrifice  to  idols  in  the 
Diocletian  persecution,  he  was  beaten  to 
death  with  whips  loaded  with  lead,  or,  ac- 
cording to  another  tradition,  with  a  spiked 
club.  The  day  of  his  martyrdom  is  com- 
memorated in  the  Gregorian  Sacramentary 
on  September  15.  In  our  Calendar  it  is 
June  1.     [H.] 

NIPTBll  {v'mreiv:  Latin,  pediluvium). 
The  ceremony  of  luashing  feet.  This  is 
performed  by  the  Greek  Christians  on  Thurs- 
day in  Holy  week  in  imitation  of  our 
Saviour,  who  on  that  day  washed  His  dis- 
ciples' feet  with  His  own  hands  (See 
Maundy-  Tliursday). 

In  the  monasteries,  the  abbot  represents 
our  Saviour,  and  twelve  of  the  monks  the 
twelve  apostles.  Among  these  the  steward 
and  jxirter  have  always  a  jjlace ;  the  former 
acts  the  part  of  St.  Peter,  and  imitates  his 
refusal  to  let  Jesus  wash  his  feet ;  the  latter 
personates  the  traitor  Judas,  and  is  loaded 
-with  scoffs  and  derision.  The  ofSce  used  on 
this  occasion  is  e.xtant  in  the  Euchdlogium. 

NOCTUHNS  (Nocturnaj  horse,  nocturnaj 
■vigiliaa).  Services  held  during  the  night. 
.Anciently  the  night  was  divided,  in  re- 
jgiou.s  houses,  into  three  parts,  at  each  of 
which  certain  psalms  were  said ;  lauds  fol- 
lovidng  at  dawn.  All  the  psalms  were  thus 
appointed  to  be  sung  weekly.  But  there 
was  great  neglect.  To  this  reference  is 
made  in  the  preface  of  the  Prayer  Book  of 
1549,  "notwithstanding  that  the  ancient 
Fathers  have  divided  the  Psalms  into  seven 
portions,  whereof  every  one  was  called  a 
nocturn ;  now  of  late  time  a  few  of  them  have 
been  said,  and  the  rest  utterly  omitted."  [H.] 

NOETIANS.     Christian  heretics  in  the 


NONCONFOEMISTS 

third  century,  followers  of  Noetns,  a  phi- 
losopher of  Ephesus,  who  affirmed  that 
there  was  but  one  person  in  the  Godhead, 
and  that  the  Word  and  the  Holy  Spirit 
were  but  external  denominations  given  to 
God  in  consequence  of  different  operations  : 
that  as  creator  he  is  called  Father ;  as  in- 
carnate. Son;  and  as  descending  upon  .the 
apostles,  the  Holy  Ghost  (Hippol.  contr. 
Hssr.  ix.  5;  Bpiphan.  Hier.  Ivii.)  (See 
Patripassians). 

NOMINALISTS.  At  the  restoration  of  the 
study  of  logic  in  the  eleventh  century,  many 
disputes  took  place,  trivial  in  their  origin, 
but  important  on  account  of  the  colour 
which  they  gave  to  religious  controversy, 
concerning  the  objects  of  logic.  Agreeing 
that  the  essential  object  of  logic  was  the 
discussion  of  wuversals,  as  distinguished 
from  particular  or  individual  things,  two 
parties  were  formed  on  the  question  whether 
universals  are  words  and  names  only,  or 
things  and  real  essences.  Those  who  de- 
clared them  to  be  only  names  and  words, 
and  who  of  course,  therefore,  determined  that 
logic  was  only  conversant  with  words,  were 
called  Nominalists,  and  basing  their  philo- 
sophy on  that  of  Aristotle,  were  principally 
supported  by  the  talent  and  authority  of 
Eoscellinus.  Those  who  held  that  universals 
were  real  existences,  and  so  that  logic  was 
conversant  with  things  and  realities,  were 
called  Realists.  They  supported  their  hypo- 
thesis on  the  authority  of  Plato.  Johannes 
Sootus  Erigena,  in  the  ninth  century,  had 
taught  this  doctrine,  but  without  leaving 
behind  him  any  school  of  avowed  followers. 
The  controversy  with  the  Nominalists  ix-as 
commenced  in  the  eleventh  century,  and  in 
the  thirteenth  the  greater  part  of  the  school 
men  were  Realists. 

NOMINATION.  There  is  or  was  such 
a  thing  occasionally  as  nomination  of  a  clerk 
to  another  person  who  has  to  present  him 
to  the  bishop,  but  it  is  probably  obsolete. 
In  such  cases  the  nominator  was  the  real 
patron,  for  the  presenter  was  bound  to  present 
the  nominee  unless  he  objected  on  the  ground 
of  immorality,  according  to  the  books,  which 
had  to  be  tried  by  a  jury.  If  the  nominator 
did  not  act  for  six  months,  and  the  presenter 
then  presented  before  the  bishop  had  collated 
under  the  lapse,  the  bishop  was  too  late  and 
had  to  accept  the  presentee. 

NONCONFORMISTS  (See  Dissenters, 
Methodists').  Till  the  reign  of  Elizabeth 
there  was  no  community  separated  from  the 
Church  of  England.  For  though  the  Lol- 
lards were  numerous,  and  laws  against  them 
were  passed  from  the  time  of  Henry  IV.  to 
Henry  VIIL,  notably  the  bloody  law  of  the 
former  king,  still  they  were  a  party  in  the 
Church.  Nonconformity  began  with  the 
refugees  from  Geneva  and  Frankfort,  who 


NONES 

about  1566  founded  their  own  congrega- 
tions and  discarded  the  use  of  the  Prayer 
Boolv.  Various  Acts  of  Parliament  tell  of 
the  increase  of  the  Nonconformists,  and 
the  desire  on  the  part  of  the  State  to  pre- 
vent the  mischiefs  of  disunion.  1  Eliz.  c. 
2,  sec.  14,  ordered  that  all  pei-sons  should 
attend  church,  and  absentees  were  to  be 
fined  12  pence.  Twenty-three  years  later 
the  fine  was  increased  to  £20  a  month; 
and  by  29  Eliz.  c.  6,  sec.  4,  6,  on  default  of 
this  payment,  the  queen  might,  by  process 
out  of  the  Exchequer,  seize  all  the  goods, 
and  two  parts  of  the  lands  of  the  offender. 
By  35  Eliz.  c.  1,  those  not  present  at  Divine 
service  for  a  month,  and  those  who  per- 
suaded people  to  attend  conventicles,  were 
to  be  committed  to  prison  without  trial,  till 
they  conformed;  failing  this  they  were  to 
abjure  and  depart  the  realm;  and  if  still 
disobedient  they  were  to  be  declared  guilty 
of  felony  without  benefit  of  clergy.  This 
Act,  though  intended  to  continue  in  force 
only  till  the  end  of  the  next  session  of  par- 
liament, was  continued  by  the  two  succeed- 
ing parliaments,  and  the  penalties  were  not 
repealed  till  1  Will.  &  Mary,  c.  18,  sec.  4. 
22  Car.  II.  c.  1 — the  conventicle  Act — de- 
clared Elizabeth's  Act  to  be  in  force,  and 
regulated  the  fines ;  and  the  next  year  (1665) 
the  "  Five  Mile  Act "  was  passed,  which 
enacted  that  those  in  orders,  or  pretended 
orders,  unless  they  made  declaration  of  assent 
to  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer,  and  sub- 
scribed the  oath  of  the  illegality  of  taking 
arms  against  the  king,  should  not  come, 
except  in  passing  upon  the  road,  within 
five  miles  of  any  city,  or  town  corporate. 
In  1670  another  "Conventicle  Act"  was 
passed ;  and  the  "  Test  Act "  (1672)  enacted 
that  all  persons  holding  office  under  the 
Crown  should  receive  the  sacrament  of  the 
Lord's  Supper  within  three  months  after 
admittance.  The  idea  had  been  that  the 
State  ought  to  train  its  subjects  in  Chris- 
tian truth  and  religious  practice;  but  ex- 
perience taught  that  this  was  impossible, 
and  that  men  would  not  have  their  opi- 
nions, if  not  their  consciences,  regulated  by 
Act  of  Parliament.  Hence  was  passed  the 
Toleration  Act  of  1688,  followed  by  others 
in  the  same  direction  (See  Toleration,  Act 
of).     [H.] 

NONES.  I.  A  term  employed  in  the 
Eonaan  Calendar,  inserted  in  many  of  the  old 
editions  of  the  Prayer  Book.  The  Nones 
were  the  fifth  day  of  each  month,  excepting 
in  March,  May,  July,  and  October,  when  the 
Nones  fell  on  the  seventh  day.  They  were 
so  called  from  their  being  the  ninth  day  in 
each  month  before  the  Ides.  II.  The  name 
of  the  service  held  in  mediajval  times  at  3 
o'clock  in  the  afternoon — the  ninth  hour. — 
Bluut's  An.  P.  Booh;   Stephens'  Booh  of 


NOEMAN 


529 


Common  Prayer,  notes  on  the  Calendar, 
p.  270. 

NONJURORS.  Those  conscientious  men 
who  refused  to  renounce  their  oath  of  alle- 
giance to  King  James  II.,  and  to  transfer  it 
to  the  Prince  of  Orange.  The  nonjuring 
bishops  were  Bancroft  (Canterbury),  Turner 
(Ely),  Lake  (Chichester),  Ken  (Bath  and 
Wells),  White  (Peterborough),  Thomas 
(Worcester),  Lloyd  (Norwich),  Frampton 
(Gloucester),  Cartwright  (Chester).  Besides 
these,  four  hundred  clergy  were  deprived  for 
refusing  to  renounce  their  oath.  Of  the 
bishops,  Tliomas,  Cartwright  and  Lake  died 
before  deprivation;  and  when  there  came 
a  question  as  to  whether  other  bishops 
should  be  consecrated  for  the  nonjuring 
congregations,  Ken  and  Frampton  took  no 
part.  Sancroft  died  before  the  consecration, 
so  there  were  three  nonjuring  bishops  to  per- 
form the  oifice— Lloyd,  White  and  Turner, 
and  they  consecrated  Hickes  and  Wagstaffe 
suffragans  of  Thetford  and  Ipswich  in  1693. 
In  1713,  Hickes,  whose  commission  as  suf- 
fragan had  been  dissolved  by  the  death  of 
his  diocesan,  in  a  most  irregular  manner  got 
two  Scotch  bishops  to  consecrate  with  him 
three  other  bishops ;  and  other  unautho- 
rized and  irregular  consecrations  followed. 
Thus  that  which  at  first  may  have  been  a 
rightful  separation  from  the  Church  of  Eng- 
land degenerated  after  a  time  into  a  schism. 
The  list  of  nonjurors  is  filled  with  names 
of  men  eminent  for  their  devotional  theo- 
logy.— Lathbury's  History  of  the  Nonjurors, 
1840.     [H.] 

NOBMAN.  The  highest  development 
of  Komanesque  architecture  in  England, 
which  succeeded  the  so-called  Saxon  (a  ruder 
form  of  Eomanesque)  at  the  Conquest,  and 
admitted  the  pointed  arch  which  marks  the 
Transition,  aboUt  1145.  It  must  be  observed, 
however,  that  many  buildings,  generally 
caUed  Norman,  and  which  agree  with  the 
Norman  style  in  all  essential  particulars  ex- 
cept in  the  accident  of  their  being  built 
before  1066,  must,  architecturally,  be  classed 
with  this  style.  The  earliest  dated  example 
of  this  style  in  England  is  probably  the 
portion  of  the  refectory  and  the  substructure 
of  the  dormitory  of  Westminster  Abbey, 
usually  attributed  to  the  time  of  Edward 
the  Confessor.  Part  of  the  dormitory  of 
Canterbury  Cathedral,  the  central  tower  and 
transepts  of  St.  Alban's  Abbey,  the  tower 
on  the  north  side  of  Eochester  Cathedral, 
the  west  front  of  MalUng  Abbey,  and  the 
keep  of  the  Tower  of  London,  date  from 
1066-1087.  The  Norman  is  so  absolutely 
distinguished  from  all  Gothic  orders  by  the 
round  arch,  that  it  is  needless  to  enter  into 
its  minor  peculiarities  beyond  saying  that 
the  imitation  of  vegetable  and  animal  forms 
had  not  come  in,  but  some  Norman  carving 

2  M 


530 


NOETH  SIDE 


contains  very  intricate  artificial  patterns. 
The  great  defect  of  Norman  building  was 
the  badness  of  its  mortar,  which  has  caused 
the  ruin  of  a  vast  quantity  of  beautiful  work, 
and  especially  of  towers  (See  Buttress,  Ga^ 
pital.  Cathedral,  Mouldinys,  Pier,  Pillar). 

NORTH  SIDE.  According  to  the  rubric 
the  minister  at  the  Holy  Communion  is  to 
stand  "  at  the  north  side  of  the  Table."  With 
regard  to  this  position  there  has  been  much 
controversy.  It  seems  advisable  therefore 
to  give  the  reasons  why  some  consider  by 
the  "  north  side  "  that  part  of  the  table  which 
is  on  the  left  hand  of  the  celebrant,  facing 
eastwards,  and  others,  the  north  end  of  the 
Table. 

I.  (1)  There  is  no  doubt  that  the  ordinary 
primitive  custom,  both  in  prayer  and  worship, 
was  that  the  minister  faced  the  east  (see 
JSast),  and  no  deviation  took  place  from  the 
ancient  practice  till  the  altar  was  directed 
to  be  placed  "  table  wise." 

(2)  The  altar  was  considered  as  having 
three  divisions — the  dexter  side,  the  middle, 
and  the  sinister  side.  This  is  clear  from 
the  rubric  in  the  Sarum  MissaL  "  Sciendum 
est  autem  quod  quicquid  a  sacerdote  dioitur 
ante  epistolam  in  dextro  cornu  altaris  ex- 

pleatur ca^tera  onmia  in  medio  altaris 

expleantur,  nisi  forte  diaconus  defuerit.  Tunc 
enim  in  sinistra  cornu  altaris  legatur  evan- 
gelium."  This  cornu  altaris  in  the  Roman 
Missal  is  called  latus  altaris,  and  the  latus 
altaris  is  the  whole  of  the  right  or  left,  north 
or  south  portion  or  side  of  the  altar,  at 
which  the  priest  stands,  but  always  facing 
east. 

(3)  In  the  first  Prayer  Book  of  Edward 
VI.  the  direction  was  that  the  priest "  should 
stand  humbly  afore  the  midst  of  the  altar  " ; 
which  was  probably  intended  to  prevent  the 
celebrant  moving  about  more  than  necessary. 
He  only  had  to  turn  to  the  people  at  the 
times  appointed. 

(4)  In  1552  the  term  north  side  was  re- 
inserted from  the  Sarum  Missal.  Bucer, 
whose  advice  was  largely  taken  with  regard 
to  the  revision  of  the  Prayer  Book,  gained 
his  knowledge  of  the  book,  as  he  was  an 
indifferent  English  scholar,  from  a  Latin 
translation  made  by  Aless  (see  Aless").  In 
this  the  old  word  was  used,  and  therefore 
the  cornu  or  latus  was  intended.  And 
Bucer  found  no  fault  with  it.  The  altar, 
however,  was  ordered  to  be  placed  "  in  the 
fashion  of  a  table,  and  to  be  placed  in  such 
part  of  the  quire  or  chancel  as  should  be 
most  meet,  so  that  the  ministers  and  com- 
municants should  be  separated  from  the  rest 
of  the  people "  (Burnet,  Hist  Reform,  ii. 
327).  The  effect  of  this  was  that  the  min- 
ister stood  in  the  same  place  with  regard  to 
the  table,  but  he  would  naturally  be  facing 
the  south. 


NORTH  SIDE 

(5)  When  the  irreverence  consequent  on 
the  novel  position  of  the  table  came  to  be 
realized,  it  was  replaced  altarwise  at  the 
east  end  of  the  church.  The  controversy 
then  arose  hotly  as  to  whether  the  celebrant 
should  also  return  to  the  old  position — at 
the  cornu,  latus,  or  side  of  the  holy  table 
or  altar.  This  was  carried  on  with  vigour, 
especially  by  Dr.  Peter  Heylin  on  the  one 
side,  and  Archbishop  Williams  on  the  other, 
in  the  17th  century. 

(6)  The  rubric  in  the  Scotch  Liturgy  is 
ambiguous ;  the  phrase  "  north  side,  or  north 
end  "  being  introduced.  This  may  be  taken 
to  imply  that  the  "  north  end  "  and  "  north 
side"  are  equivalent  terms  (See  2nd  part 
of  this  article).  But  it  may  equally  be  un- 
derstood as  giving  a  latitude  to  the  minister 
to  stand  in  either  position;  and  this,  con- 
sidedng  the  circumstances  under  which  the 
Scotch  Prayer  Book  was  compiled,  and  the 
controversy  between  the  Puritans  and  Ra- 
tionalists, as  Laud  calls  them  (i.e.  admirers 
of  Durand's  Rationale),  which  was  going 
on,  seems  the  more  probable  (See  Laud's 
Works,  iii.  347). 

(7)  The  rubric  in  our  present  Prayer 
Book  is  similar  to  that  of  1552.  As  the 
words  "  north  side "  are  used,  it  would 
seem  to  have  been  the  intention  of  the 
Revisers  that  the  minister  should  stand 
in  the  old  position  with  regard  to  the 
altar,  i.e.  at  the  nortii  cornu  or  latus — 
translated  side. 

(8)  In  the  order  of  the  service  at  the 
coronation  of  Queen  Victoria  (June  28th, 
1838),  which  is  similar  to  that  used  at  all 
previous  consecrations  since  the  Reforma- 
tion, the  Queen's  chair  was  "  set  for  her  on 
the  south  side  of  the  altar."  On  the  north 
side  "  sits  the  archbishop  in  a  purple  velvet 
chair"':  "on  the  south  side  east  of  the 
Queen's  chair  stand  the  dean,  &c."  "  On 
the  right  hand  of  the  Queen  stands  the 
Bishop  of  Durham,  and  beyond  him  on  the 
same  side  the  lords  that  carried  the  swords : 
on  her  left  hand  the  Bishop  of  Bath  and 
Wells,  and  the  great  Lord  Chamberlain." 
These  directions  show  that  the  Queen  could 
not  have  been  at  the  south  end  of  the  altar. 
But  an  eye-witness  also  states  the  fact :  "  I 
was  present,"  writes  Mr.  G-.  T.  0.  Bridge- 
man  (Guardian,  Jan.  20th,  1875),  "  at  the 
coronation  of  Queen  Victoria;  and  I  can 
vouch  for  the  fact  that  her  seat  at  that  part 
of  the  service  was  actually  before  the  south 
part  of  the  west  side  of  the  holy  table  ;  and, 
indeed,  from  the  context,  the  direction  could 
not  possibly  be  interpreted  to  mean  the 
south  end.  If,  then,  custom  from  time  im- 
memorial has  recognised  this  interpretation 
of  the  south  side,  it  is  difficult  to  see  how 
a  similar  interpretation  of  the  north  side 
can  be  justly  excluded"  (Coronation  8er- 


NORTH  SIDE 

vice  according  to  the  Use  of  tlieChwch  of 
liwiland,  by  J.  F.  Russell,  B.C.L.,  F.S.A., 
1875 ;  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  Heel  Ana.  ii.  Ixx., 
,&c.).     [H.] 

II.  On  the  other  hand,  in  the  opinion  of 
some,  and  according  to  certain  legal  deci- 
sions, "  end  "  and  "  side  "  are  the  same. 

One  of  the    most   contested   points   in 
-.he  ritualistic   lawsuits   was  the  question 
whether  the  priest  is  at  liberty  to  say  the 
prayer  of  consecration  facing  eastwards,  i.e. 
to  what  is  always  called  the  east  end  of  the 
church,  whether  it  stands  cardinally  or  not. 
At  St.  Peter's,  Rome,  the  so-called  east  end 
is  at  the  west ;  and   "  orientation "  seems 
to  be  very  little  regarded  in  Italy.     In  the 
same  way,  the  "  north  side  of  the  table  "  is 
universally  taken  and  has  been  decided  to 
mean  that  side  of  it  which  is  north  relatively 
to  that   which  is  or  is  called  east.     The 
verbal  dispute  whether  "  side "  can  mean 
what  is  otherwise  called  "end"  has  been 
put  aside  by  decisions  in  conformity  with 
ordinary  definitions  in  dictionaries,  and  also 
with  the  very  decisive  phrase  in  the  Scotch 
liturgy,  which  was  framed  from  ours,  "  the 
north  side  or  end  of  the  table ; "  which  was 
probably  used  also  to  cover  both  positions 
of  the  table  itself,  whether  a  long  side  faces 
north  or  east.     A  side  of  a  parallelogram 
is   not   less   a  side  because  it  is  not  the 
widest.     And  unquestionably  it  is  not  a 
•comer,  as  some  clergymen  seem  to  imagine. 
And  as  the  rubric  positively  directs  the  min- 
ister  to  begin  the  service  "  standing  at  the 
north  side  of  the  table,"  no  ingenuity  can 
■get  over  that  whatever  doubt  there  may 
be  as  to  the  consecration  prayer.     Standing 
anysvhere  else  but  at  the  north  side,  until 
the  consecration  prayer  at  any  rate,  is  an 
absolute  defiance  of  the  plainest  written 
law  and  decisions  of  the   Supreme   Court. 
Every    conceivable    argument    about    the 
lawful  position  at    consecration   has   lieen 
thrashed  out  over  and  over  again  in  the 
various  lawsuits  and  books,  and  it  is  useless 
to  say  more  than  that  in  the  Purchas  case 
(3  P.  C.  634)  the  Judicial  Committee  unani- 
mously decided  (the  defendant  not  appear- 
ing, either  by  himself  or  counsel)  that  as  soon 
■■as  the  priest  has  finished  "  ordering  the  bread 
and  wine "  on  the  table  according  to  the 
rubric  before  the  consecration  prayer,  he 
must  return  to  the  north  side — ^if  he  had  left 
it,  which  he  need  not  do  unless  he  likes, 
TDecause  there  only  can  he  break  the  bread 
in  the  sight  of  the  people ;  and  that  because 
"standing  before  the   table"  only  means 
standing  anywhere  at  the  table.     But  in  the 
Ridsdale  case  (2  Prob.  Div.  304)  a  later  Ju- 
■dicial   Committee,   which   was  notoriously 
divided  on  some  points,  held  that  he  may 
■Stand  before  the  table  in  the  sense  of  any- 
■where  round  it,  east,  west,  north,  or  south, 


NOETH  SIDE 


531 


all  through  the  prayer,  provided  he  tabes  care 
to  break  the  bread  and  take  the  cup  (but  he 
must  not  "  elevate  "  it,  as  the  Papists  do)  in 
the  sight  of  the  people :  not  a  very  easy  feat 
to  perform  with  his  back  to  them ;  and  it  is 
remarkable  that  in  the  onlj'-  case  since 
decided,  it  was  held  that  the  priest  had  not 
successfully  performed  it,  and  he  was  con- 
demned accordingly.  That  Committee  added 
that  if  they  were  bound  to  decide  which  side 
the  piiest  ought  to  stand  at  in  consecrating, 
they  should  say  the  north,  for  that  manifest 
reason.  Whichever  side  the  makers  of  the 
present  Prayer  Book  really  meant — and 
every  side  but  south  has  had  its  advocates, 
for  the  east  side  was  undoubtedly  used  in 
early  times — nobody  can  believe  that  they 
meant  it  to  be  optional ;  and  therefore  that 
decision  is  the  most  certain  of  all  possible 
ones  to  be  wrong,  in  the  sense  of  being 
contrary  to  the  original  intention.  How- 
ever, such  is  the  law  now,  viz. :  the  position 
is  optional  during  consecration  if  the  priest 
can  perform  the  feat  aforesaid,  but  the  north 
side  is  imperative  until  then,  and  therefore 
also,  we  presume,  during  the  short  remainder 
of  the  service  which  is  clearly  not  covered 
by  this  consecration  rubric. 

It  should  be  mentioned  that  a  still  earlier 
decision  in  the  Mackonochie  case  (2  P.  C. 
365)  was  generally  misunderstood  (and  by  no 
means  unnaturally,  from  an  obscurity  in  its 
language  which  Lord  Cairns  confessed  to  in 
the  Ridsdale  case)  to  have  actually  ordered 
standing  before,  in  the  sense  of  "west  of,"  the 
table,  which,  he  said,  was  quite  contrary  to 
the  intention  of  the  Court.  It  was  foreseen 
by  some  people,  and  it  is  strange  that  it  was 
not  by  him — or,  that  he  would  not  attend 
to  it  when  it  was  pointed  out  to  him — that 
ordinary  persons  would  he  sure  to  misun- 
derstand it,  as  many  did  who  had  not  the 
least  wish  to  move  from  their  old  north  side 
habits.  It  is  no  less  strange  that  he  should 
have  thought  it  worth  while  (for  he  avowed 
his  opinion  early  in  a  speech)  to  vary  the 
unanimous  Purchas  judgment  of  the  same 
court  and  two  previous  Chancellors,  for  such 
a  hair-splitting  reason  as  he  gave  for  it, 
while  admitting  that  the  proper  place  (if 
not  the  only  legal  one)  was  that  which  the 
Purchas  judgment  had  afiSrmed.  In  the 
same  way  the  unlucky  and  unnecessary 
introduction  of  the  word  "dresses"  before 
(church)  "  decorations "  in  the  Liddell  v. 
Westerton  judgment,  which  had  nothing  to 
do  with  dresses  or  vestments,  led  to  some 
years  of  clerical  misapprehension  of  the  law 
about  them.  There  seems  to  have  been  in 
all  times  a  fatality  of  ambiguity  in  the 
rubrics  and  statutes  and  judgments  upon 
these  matters,  either  from  carelessness  or 
something  worse.  See  Dean  Howson's  Be- 
fore the  Table.     [G.] 

2  M  2 


532 


NOTES 


NOTES     OF    THE    CHTJECH.      The 
necessity  of  devising  some  general  notes 
of  the  Chnrch,   and  of   not    entering    at 
once  on  controversial  debates    concerning 
all   points  of  doctrine  and  discipline,  was 
early  perceived  by  Christian    theologians. 
Tertulliau   (Prmscr.  xiii.  xx.)  appeals,   in 
refutation  of  the  heresies  of  his  age,  to  the 
antiquity  of  the  Church  derived  from  the 
apostles,   and  its  priority  to  all  heretical 
communities ;  Irenajus  (Gontr.  Hxr.  1,  2,  3) 
to  the  unity  of  the  Church's  doctrines,  and 
the   succession   of  her   bishops    from    the 
apostles ;  St.  Augustine  (De  V.  Rel.  8 :  de 
Unit.  Heel.  6,  17)  to  oecumenical  consent, 
and   the  name    "  Catholic ; "    St.   Jerome, 
to  the  continued  duration  of  the  Church 
from  the  apostles,   and  the   very  appella- 
tion of  the    Christian    name.      In  mod- 
em times,   Bellarmine  the  Eomanist   (De 
Notts  Eecl.  iv.  1-3)  added   several  other 
notes,  making  15  in  all,  such  as, — agree- 
ment with  the   primitive  Church  in  doc- 
trine ;  union  of  members  among  themselves 
and  with  their  head;  sanctity  of  doctrine 
and  of  founders  ;  continuance  of  miracles 
and  prophecy ;   confession  of  adversaries ; 
the  unhappy  end  of  those  who  are  opposed 
to  the  Church,  and  the  temporal   felicity 
conferred  on  it.    Jeremy  Taylor,  however, 
refutes  these,  proving  them  not  to  be  truly 
"Notes  of  the  Church  "(vol.  x.  p.  357,Heber's 
ed.).     Luther  (Ke  Eecl.  Notis,  vii.  147,  ed. 
1550)  assigned  as  notes  of  the  true  Church, 
the  true  and  uncorrupted  preaching  of  the 
gospel ;   administration  of  baptism,  of  the 
Eucharist,  and  of  the  keys;   a  legitimate 
ministry,  public  service  in  a  known  tongue, 
and  tribulations  internally  and  externally. 
Calvin    (Inst.    iv.    i.    10)   reckons    only 
truth  of  doctrine,  and  right  administration 
of  the  sacraments,  and  seems  to  reject  suc- 
cession.    The  learned  theologians   of  the 
Church  of  England  adopt  a  different  view 
in  some  respects.     Dr.  Field  (Of  the  Gh.  ii. 
i.  2-5)  admits  the  following  notes  of  the 
Church :  truth  of  doctrine ;   use  of  sacra- 
ments  and   means    instituted    by   Christ; 
union  under  lawful   ministers;   antiquity 
without  change  of  doctrine ;   lawful  suc- 
cession, i.e.  with  true  doctrine ;  and  uni- 
versality in  the    suceessive   sense,  i.e.  the 
prevalence  of  the  Church  successively  in  all 
nations.     Bishop  Taylor  admits,  as  notes  of 
the  Church,  antiquity,  duration,  succession 
of  bishops,  union  of  members  among  them- 
selves and  with  Christ,   sanctity  of  doc- 
trine, &c.    (Dissuasive  from  Popery,  pt.-  ii.). 
The  attributes  aflSrmed  of  the  Church  in 
the  Nicene  Creed    (as    enlarged    at    Con- 
stantinople in  A.D.   381)  may  be  taken  as 
"  Notes  of  the  Church — One,  Holy,  Catholic, 
and   Apostolic." — Palmer,    Treatise  on   the 
aiurcli,  i.  17-21. 


NOVATIANS 

NOVATIANS.    A  Christian  sect  whicU 
sprang  up  in  the  third  century,  called  after 
Novatian,    their    founder.      This    man,   a 
priest   of  Home,  opposed  the  elevation  of 
Cornelius  to  the  Episcopate  of  the  Roman 
Church,  either,  as  some  assert,  because  he 
aimed  at  that  dignity  himself,  or,   as   iw 
more    likely,    because    he    thought    that 
Cornelius  had  displayed  too  great  a  lenity 
towards  those  who  had  lapsed  dm-ing  the 
Decian  persecution.     Novatian  was  a  man 
of  unsocial  and  stern  habits  (Cornel.  Epist. 
in  Euseb.  II.  E.  vi.  43),  and  it  was  not  till 
Novatus  of  Carthage  joined  him,  that  the 
schism  really  took  place  (Cypr.  Ep.  49). 
Novatian  was  consecrated  by  three  Italian 
bishops    from    a    distance,   who   were    by 
some  means  induced  to  perform  the  rite, 
but  of  whom  two  were  deposed,  and  the 
other  on  repentance  admitted  only  to  lay 
communion  (Euseb.  H.  E.  vi.  43 :    Cypr. 
Ep.  xlix.-lv.).     The  Novatians  maintained 
that  those  who  had  lapsed  ought  indeed  to 
be  exhorted  to  repentance,  but  never  to  be 
absolved   by  the   Church,  reserving  their 
absolution    to   God    alone,   who    had    the 
power  and  authority  to  remit  sins.    Hence 
they  came   to  deny,  in   general,   that   the 
Church  had  the  power  of  remitting  mortal 
sins,  upon  the  offender's  repentance.    And 
they  even  went  so  far  as   to   deny   that 
apostates  could  ever  hope  for  pardon  even 
from  God  himself:    a  doctrine  which   so 
terrified  some  of  those  who  had  lapsed  and 
repented,  that,   in  despair,  they  quite  ab- 
jured   Christianity,   and    returned   to   Pa- 
ganism. They  also  asserted  the  unlawfulness 
of  second  mamages;  against  which  they 
were  as  severe  as  against  apostates ;  denying- 
communion   for  ever  to  such  persons   as 
married  a  second  time  after  baptism,  and 
treating    widows    who    married    again    as 
adulteresses.    They  rebaptized  those  they 
gained  over  to  their  sect.     This,  however,, 
was  the  practice  in   the  African  Church 
(Tertul.  de  Baptismo,  15 :  de  Prmsc.  12,  &c.). 
In  baptising,  they  used  the  received  forms 
of  the  Church,  and  had  the  same  belief 
concerning    the    Father,    Son,   and    Holy 
Ghost,  in  Whose  name  they  baptized.     Su 
Cyprian  rejected  their  baptism,  as  he  did 
that  of  all  heretics  (Ep.  70) ;  but  it  was 
admitted  by  the  eighth  canon  of  the  Coun- 
cil of  Nice.     The  Novatians  took  the  name- 
of  Cathari,  that  is,  the  Pure,  or  Puritans ; 
and  like  the   Pharisees  among  the  Jews, 
they  would  not  suffer  other  men  to  come 
near  them,  lest    their    purity  should    be 
defiled  thereby  (Socr.  H.  E.  vii.  25). 

The  schism  which  Novatian  had  formed 
in  the  Roman  Church  was  not  confined  to 
Rome,  nor  to  Italy,  nor  even  to  the  West. 
It  made  its  way  into  the  Bast,  and  subsisted 
a  long  time  at  Alexandria,  in  several  prov- 


NOVICES 

inces  of  Asia,  at  Constautinople,  in  Scythia, 
juid  in  Africa.  Tlie  Novatians  abounded 
particularly  in  Pkrygia  and  Paphlagonia. 
4vOnstantine  seems  to  have  favoured  them  a 
little  by  a  law  of  the  year  326  ;  which 
preserves  to  them  their  churches  and 
burying-places,  provided  they  never  be- 
longed to  the  Catholic  Church  (^God. 
Theodos.  lib.  xvL,  tit.  5,  1.  2).  The  Nova- 
tians, or  Cathari,  were  also  treated  gently 
by  the  Councils  of  Nicsea  (Can.  viii.), 
Laodicea,  a.d.  367  (Can.  vii.),  and  Con- 
stantinople, A.D.  381  (Can.  vii.),  for  they 
were  not  regarded  as  heretical  on  the  great 
docti-ines  of  the  faith.  They  had  to  give  in 
a  written  renunciation  of  their  errors,  and 
were  then  to  be  received.  The  Novatian 
sect  was  reduced  to  a  very  inconsiderable 
party  about  the  end  of  the  fifth  century 
^Grieseler,  c.  iv.  sec.  69;  Walch,  Sist.  der 
Ketzereien,  ii.  p.  226  seq. ;  Bingham,  iv.  7). 
NOVICES,  in  countries  where  Monachism 
prevails,  are  those  persons  who  are  candi- 
dates, or  probationers,  for  a  religious  life. 
The  time  of  their  probation  is  ,  called  the 
.  Noviciate ;  after  which,  if  their  behaviour  is 
approved,  they  are  professed,  that  is,  ad- 
mitted into  the  order,  and  allowed  to  make 
the  vows,  wear  the  habit,  &c. 

I.  The  period  and  severity  of  the  pro- 
bation varied  at  different  times.  Gregory 
the  Great,  finding  that  there  had  been  laxity 
in  this  respect,  ordered  that  two  years  at 
least  should  be  required  (jSp.  x.  24).  But 
the  usual  time  seems  to  have  been  one  year, 
during  which  the  novice  imderwent  severe 
training.  He  was  placed  under  a  senior 
monk,  or  "master";  was  not  allowed  to 
«tir  out  of  his  chamber  without  leave ;  had 
hard  menial  labours  to  perform;  had  to 
rest  his  head  bent  forward  as  a  token  of 
humility  (Jleg.  Bened.  Comment,  c.  7) ;  and 
from  "  lauds  "  to  "  prime,"  when  the  monks 
liad  retired  to  their  cells,  he  had  to  stay  up 
in  his  dormitory  learning  psalms  (Hospin. 
Hist.  Monach.  iii.  c.  23).  If  under  these 
circumstances  the  novice  wished  to  change 
his  determination,  he  could  do  so.  At  the 
end  of  two,  and  of  eight  months,  and  again 
at  the  end  of  the  year,  the  rule  was  read  to 
him  bidding  him  go  back  to  the  world  if  he 
wished  it.  In  the  earliest  times,  indeed, 
there  was  no  vow  of  perpetuity,  and  if  a 
novice,  after  making  his  profession,  turned 
back  to  the  world,  he  would  forfeit  what 
he  had  brought  to  the  monastery,  but  be 
allowed  to  depart,  and  "make  his  peace  with 
God  "  (St.  Chrysost.  adv.  Vituperatores  Vita: 
Monast.  lib.  iii. ;  Justin.  Novell,  v.).  But 
afterwards,  if  a  novice  did  at  the  last  moment 
retract,  he  might  go,  but  under  such  sentence 
•of  penance  for  his  levity  of  purpose  as  made 
it  hard  for  him. 

XL.  The    novices   were   generally   lodged 


NUNS 


533 


in  a  dormitory  at  the  end  of  the  monks' 
cloister.  The  Cistercians  usually  placed 
them  apart,  under  their  master,  at  the  west 
side  of  the  cloister ;  and  this  was  the  case 
at  Winchester.  In  the  old  Cathedral  of 
Canterbury  indeed  their  school  was  in  the 
north  tower  of  the  nave  ;  but  in  Benedictine 
monasteries  they  studied  in  the  western  alley 
of  the  great  cloister. — Hospinian,  de  Orig. 
Monach.;  Bingham,  vii.  c.  3;  Mabillon, 
Prmf.  iv.  vii.  150 ;  Bellarmine,  de  Monach. 
lib.  2,  c.  6 ;  Walcott's  Sac.  Arch.  p.  402 ; 
Diet,  of  Christ.  Ant.  1405  seq.     [H.] 

NUMBERS,  THE  BOOK  OP.  A  can- 
onical book  of  the  Old  Testament.  It  is  the 
fourth  book  of  the  Pentateuch,  and  receives 
its  name  from  the  numbering  of  the  families 
of  Israel  by  Moses  and  Aaron  (See  Penta- 
teuch :  Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible). 

NUNS  (Sax.  nunne ;  Fr.  nonne).  "Wo- 
men who  devote  themselves  to  a  religious 
life.  The  word  is  probably  derived  from 
nonna,  a  tenn  implying  filial  reverence 
as  given,  in  the  first  place,  to  a  mother, 
grandmother,  or  aged  nurse.  The  males 
among  the  "  religious  "  were  called  nonni 
in  early  times  (Hieron.  Ep.  '22,  ad  Eu- 
stochium).  Another  derivation  given  by 
Hospinian  is  from  vovis,  an  Egypto-Greek 
word  used  sometimes  by  Palladius  (Hosp.  de 
Monach.  lib.  i.  c.  1). 

1.    These  were  women   in  the  ancient 
Christian  Church,   who  made  public  and 
open  profession  of  religion  as  virgins,  before 
the  monastic  life    or    name  was    known. 
These  are  frequently  mentioned  by  the  early 
Fathers,  such  as  Ignatius,  TertuUian,  and 
Cyprian ;   and  they  are  sometimes   called 
ecclesiastical  virgins    to  distinguish   them  ; 
from  such  as  embraced  the  monastic  life,  i 
when    monasteries    multiplied ;    and    also  ' 
canoniex  from  their  being  registered  in  the 
Canon,  or  books  of  the  Church  (Soz.  S.  E. 
lib.  8,  c.  23  :  Socrat.  1,  17).     But  they  did  i 
not  live  in   communities,   nor  were  they 
bound  by  vows  (Cypr.   Ep.  4,  62  :  62  o^  | 
Pompon.).     The  empress   Helena   shewed 
great  interest  in  these  devoted  women,  and 
often  entertained  them  and  waited  on  them 
at  her  own  table  (Socrat.  H.  E.  i.  17). 

II.  In  the  4th  century  we  read  of  "  sacred 
virgins"  living  with  their  parents,  while  j 
mention  is  also  made  of  communities.  The 
third  Council  of  Carthage,  a.d.  397,  orders  ) 
that  if  any  of  these  virgins  ("sacraj  vir- 
gines  "  )  should  be  deprived  of  their  parents, 
they  should  be  placed  (commendentur)  in  a 
monastery  of  virgins,  or  with  other  women 
(Can.  33).  St.  Ohrysostom  mentions  associ- 
ations of  virgins  (castus  virginum)  in 
Egypt  {Horn,  in  Matt.  c.  8) ;  St.  Ambrose 
in  Alexandria,  and  the  East  generally  (De 
Virg.  7 :  de  Virgin.  10)  ;  and  references  are 
made  to  them,  among  other  early  writers,  by 


534 


NUNS 


St.  Augustine  (De  Mor.  Ecd.  c.  31)  and  St. 
Jerome,  who  complained  that  parents  were 
ready  to  get  rid  of  ill-favoured  daughters 
in  this  way  (_Ep.  ad  Demetriad.).  At  the 
end  of  the  4th  century  there  were  said  to 
have  been  40,000  "  religious "  women  in 
Egypt. 

III.  With  regard  to  the  age  of  admission, 
rules  were  various.  St.  Ambrose  says  that 
it  should  not  depend  upon  years,  but  upon 
maturity  of  character  (Jbe  Virg.  7).  Sixteen 
or  seventeen  years  of  age  was  by  some  con- 
sidered sufficient,  and  this  was  the  age 
which  St.  Basil  allowed  (^Ep.  ad  Amphiloch. 
c.  18).  But  opinions  varied ;  and  while  at 
the  third  Council  of  Carthage  (Can.  4)  vir- 
gins might  be  consecrated  at  the  age  of 
twenty-five,  at  the  Coimcil  of  Saragossa, 
held  about  the  same  date,  the  veil  was 
forbidden  before  the  age  of  forty  (Can.  8).  As 
time  went  on  the  greater  age  seems  to 
have  been  considered  necessary,  and  forty 
years  was  the  age  assigned  by  the  Coun- 
cil of  Agde,  about  100  years  after  those 
of  Carthage  and  Saragossa  (Can.  19,  A.n. 
506).  There  was  a  difference  made,  how- 
ever, between  professing,  and  taking  the 
veil,  and  this  may  account  for  the  discre- 
pancy. Gregory  the  Great  pronounced  that 
nuns  might  not  take  the  veil  before  sixty 
years  of  age,  but  the  profession  might  be 
made  earher  {Ep.  iv.  11).  The  Emperor 
Charles  the  Great,4n  ^.d.  789  and  805,  fixed 
the  time  for  profession  according  to  the  old 
councils,  at  twenty-five  {Capital,  c.  46:  c. 

'  IV.  The  rule  of  perpetual  virginity  does 
1  not  seem  to  have  been  at  first  an  obligatory 
'  one.  It  is  clear  from  St.  Cyprian  that  in  his 
time  the  virgins  were  under  no  obligation  of 
any  formal  vow  (Bp.  Fell,  on  St.  Cyprian,  4). 
"  If  they  are  unwilling  to  persevere,"  he 
says,  "  or  are  unable,  let  them  marry."  "  Si 
perseverare  nolunt,  vel  non  possunt :  melius 
est  nubant  quam  in  ignem  delictis  suis 
cadant"  {Ep.  Ixii.  al.  4,  ad  Pompon.}.  But 
in  the  following  ages  marriages  of  nuns 
were  regarded  with  great  disapprobation, 
and  censures  of  the  Church  were  inflicted  on 
them.  St.  Augustine  wrote  against  such 
marriages,  which  he  considered  as  very 
culpable,  though  not  invalid  (De  Bono 
Viduitat.  8,  9, 10).  St.  Jerome  spoke  more 
sternly  on  the  subject  (Ep.  ad  Demetriad.'), 
and  St.  Basil  considered  the  marriage  of 
"  one  who  is  already  the  spouse  of  Christ "  as 
adultery  {Ep.  ad  AmpMloch.  c.  18).  Many 
of  the  councils  regarded  the  marriage  of  a 
nun  as  a  matter  of  immorality,  and  ordered 
penance  before  forgiveness.  Thus  the 
Council  of  Chalcedon  (a.d.  451),  whOe  pre- 
scribing penance  according  to  the  discretion 
of  the  bishop,  recommended  the  erring 
sister  to  mercy  (C.   16).    Other  councils. 


NUNS 

however,  were  not  so  lenient,  and  Gregory 
the  Great  spoke  in  the  strongest  term's  of 
the  marriage  of  a  nun,  characterizing  it  as  a 
great  wickedness  {Ep.  iv.  24).    It  is  to  be 
observed  however  that  he  dealt  not  only 
with  the  marriage,  but  the  chastity  of  the 
professed  {Ep.  iv.  9).    The  Imperial  laws 
decreed  that  if  any  virgin  was  veiled  before  , 
the  age  of  forty,  either  by  the  violence  or 
hatred  of  her   parents  (which  was  a  case  i 
which  often  happened),  she  was  at  liberty  to 
marry  {God.  Theod.  Nov.  viii.  ix.).     It  was 
not  till  the  Benedictine  rule  had  been  es-/ 
tablished  in  Europe,  that  the  vow  of  vir-' 
ginity  was  considered  irrevocable. 

V.  The  consecration  of  virgins  had 
some  things  peculiar  in  it.  It  was  usually 
performed  publicly  in  the  church  by  the 
bishop,  the  usual  times  for  the  ceremony 
being  Epiphany,  Easter,  and  the  festivals 
of  the  Apostles  (Gelasius,  Ep.  ix.  ad  Episc. 
Lucan.  c.  12).  The  virgin  made  a  public 
profession  of  her  resolution,  and  then  the 
bishop  put  upon  her  the  accustomed  habit 
of  sacred  virgins.  One  part  of  this  habit 
was  a  veil,  called  the  sacrum  velamen, 
which  was  a  sign  of  belonging  to  Christ 
alone  (Athan.  Exliort.  ad  Spons.  Dei); 
another  was  a  kind  of  mitre,  or  coronet, 
worn  on  the  head.  In  some  places  the 
custom  of  shaving  professed  virgins  pre- 
vailed ;  as  it  did  in  the  monasteries  of  Syria 
and  Egypt  in  St.  Jerome's  time :  but  the 
Council  of  Gangra  strongly  condemned  this 
practice,  accounting  that  a  woman's  hair 
was  given  her  by  God  as  a  mark  of  subjec- 
tion. And  the  custom  was  to  gather  up  and 
tie  the  tresses,  as  a  distinction  between  this 
and  the  worldly  marriage,  when  the  tresses 
would  be  loosened  and  flowing.  Theodosius- 
the  Great  added  a  civil  sanction  to  the 
ecclesiastical  decree  against  cutting  off  the 
hair,  whence  it  appears  that  the  tonsure  of 
virgins  was  anciently  no  allowed  custom  of 
the  Church,  however  it  came  to  prevail  iiii 
the  contrary  practice  of  later  ages  {Cod, 
Theod.  xvi.  ii.  27). 

An  ancient  Gallican  form  at  the  "  veiling  "■ 
of  a  nun  is  given  by  Mabillon  {De  Litm-g. 
Gall.  3,  p.  311).  An  English  "  Order  of 
Consecration  of  Nuns  "  may  be  found  in  Has- 
kell's "  Monumenta"of  the  Anglican  Church, 
.of  which  he  says,  "  very  much  of  this  office 
can  be  traced  to  the  highest  antiquity  irt 
the  English  Church :  many  of  the  prayers 
are  in  the  earliest  pontifical  extant,  that  of 
Archbishop  Egbert,  a  contemporary  of  the 
Venerable  Bede"  (vol.  iii.  p.  334).  The  in-  ] 
terior  government  of  a  nunnery  ,is  entrusted/ 
to  an  abbess  or  superior,  but  the  spiritual 
rule  is  in  the  hands  of  the  bishop.  Tho\ 
various  orders  of  nuns  were  founded  on 
modifications  of  the  three  great  rules  of  St.  / 
Basil,  St.,  Benedict,  and  St.  Augustine. 


NUNC  DIMITTIS 

I     VI.   The  earliest  regulation  of  convents 
in   England  was   made  at  the  Council  of 
Cloveshoo,  A.D.  747,  when  irregular  visits  of 
I  laymen,  relaxation  of  discipline,  and  the  use 
j  of  gay  apparel  was  forbidden.     In  a.d.  877, 
i  by  the  dispensation  of  the  king  or  bishop  a 
I  nun  might  leave  the  convent  and  marry ; 
;  nevertheless  in  a.d.  785  it  had  been  declared 
^adulterous  to  marry  a  nun,  and  in  943  such 
marriage  was  branded  as  incest.     This  dis- 
crepancy may  be  accounted  for  by  the  fact 
that  there  were  two  classes  of  nuns,  the 
"mynchen"  (jiovdxai-)    and    "nonna;,"    of 
whom  the  former  observed  a  stricter  dis- 
cipline.   Frequent  rules  were  laid  down  with 
regard  to  their  dress,  as  at  the  Council  of 
Osney,  a.d.  1222  (Can.  32).     The  Beguine 
nuns  were  founded  by  St.  Begga  (a.d.  698) 
under  the  Augustine  rule ;   the  Benedictine 
nuns,  founded  by  St.  Scholaslica  in  530,  had 
a  house  at  Wilton  in  773;  the  Franciscans, 
or  Minoresses,  founded  1212,  came  to  Eng- 
land in  1293,  and  were  first  established  in 
the  " Minories,"  London ;  the  "poor  Clares," 
founded  in  1225  by  St.  Clara  of  Assisi,  were 
another  branch ;  the  Bridgetines  were  estab- 
lished at  Sion,  Middlesex,  in  1415.    Nunnery 
churches  of  the  Benedictines,  amongst  other 
places,  remain  at  Jesus  College,  Cambridge, 
Itomsey,  and  St.  Helens,  Bishopsgate,  and 
a  smaller  one  at  Minster,  Isle  of  Sheppey, 
where  the  parishioners  occupied  one  aisle, 
divided  from  the  rest  of  the  church.- — Bing- 
ham's Ant.  vii.  4  :  ii.  22  ;  Broughton,  Biblio. 
vol.  ii. ;  Wilkins'  Concil.  i.  585  :  ii.  51,  &c. ; 
Hook's  Archbishops,  i.  227  :  ii.  751 :  iii.  347  ; 
Walcott's  Sacr.  Arch. ;  Diet.   Christ.  Ant.  ; 
Blunt's  Diet.  s.  v.  "  Nuns."     [H.] 

NUNC  DIMITTIS.  The  first  words  in 
Latin  of  the  Song  of  Simeon,  "Lord,  now 
lettest  thou  thy  servant  depart  in  peace " 
(St.  Luke  ii.  29),  appointed  as  one  of  the 
hymns  to  be  used  after  the  second  lesson 
at  evensong.  It  was  used  in  the  church 
services  in  the  most  ancient  times.  It  is 
found  in  the  Apostolical  Constitutions,  and 
at  the  present  day  this  hymn  is  repeated 
at  evening  prayer  in  the  patriarchate  of 
Constantinople.  The  hymn  occurs  in  the 
Latin  office  for  compline,  from  which,  and 
from  the  vesper  service,  our  olBce  of  Evening 
Prayer  was  compiled. 

NUNCIO.  An  ambassador  from  the  pope 
to  some  prince  or  state;  or  a  person  who 
attends  on  the  pope's  behalf  at  a  congress, 
or  at  an  assembly  of  several  ambassadors. 
A  nuncio,  in  fact,  is  the  pope's  ambassador, 
as  the  internuncio  is  his  envoy  extraordinary. 
A  nuncio  has  a  jurisdiction,  and  may  delegate 
judges  in  all  the  states  where  he  resides, 
except  in  Prance,  where  he  has  no  authority 
beyond  that  of  a  simple  ambassador.  Some- 
times a  nuncio  is  invested  with  the  functions 
of  a  legatus  natus  (See  Legate). 


OATH 


535 


o. 

0  SAPIENTIA.  "0  Wisdom"— the 
opening  words  of  the  first  of  seven  short 
antiphons  formerly  sung  between  Decem- 
ber 16  and  Christmas  Eve.  Each  is  founded 
on  some  title  of  our  Lord  derived  from  Holy 
Scripture.  The  other  antiphons  respectively 
began :  (2)  0  Adonai,  (3)  0  Radix  Jesu,  (4) 
0  Clavis  David,  (5)  0  Oriens  Splendor,  (6) 
0  Rex  Gentium,  (7)  0  Emmanuel.  They 
were  vulgarly  called  "the  O's." 

OATH  (Sax.  ath).  I.  At  Coronations.  From 
very  early  times  in  Christian  States,  the 
Sovereign,  when  consecrated  and  crowned, 
took  an  oath  to  uphold  religion  and  main- 
tain the  integrity  of  the  kingdom.     The 
Anglo-Saxon  oath  of  King  Ethelred  is  still 
preserved  (Cotton  MS.  B.  xiij. :  it  is  printed 
in  Hiokes'  Instit.  Anglo-Saxonicss),  and  to 
that  of  St.  Edward  reference  in  subsequent 
coronations  is  made.     The  oath  was  given 
to  Edward  III.  to  rule  "  par  le  glorious  roy 
Seint  Edward  vestre  predecessour";  to  Henry 
VIII.  that  he  would  "  kepe  the  spiritual  laws 
and  libertees  grauntedto  the  clergy  and  people 
your  noble  predecessor   and   Kyng,   Seint 
Edward."    At  James  II.'s  coronation  similar 
words    were  used    (Rolls,  iii.   417;    New 
Rymer.ii.  33,  &c.;  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  ii.  113, 
&c.).     The  coronation  oath  taken  by  Queen 
Victoria  dates  from  1  Will.  &  Mary ;  slightly 
changed  by  6  Anne,  c.  8,  and  40  Geo.  III. 
c.   67,   by  which  the  "settlement  of  the 
United  Church  of  England  and  Ireland" 
was  substituted  for  the  "  settlement  of  the 
realm."    The  archbishop  asked  the  question, 
"Will  you  to  the  utmost  of  your  Power 
maintain  the  laws  of  God,  the  true  professiori 
of  the  Gospel  and  the  Protestant  Reformed 
Religion  established  by  Law?     And  will 
you  maintain  and  preserve  inviolably  the 
settlement  of  the  United  Church  of  England 
and  Ireland,  and  the  Doctrine,  Worship,  and 
Government  thereof,  as  by  Law  established 
within  England  and  Ireland,  and  the  Terri- 
tories thereunto  belonging  ?     And  will  you 
preserve  unto  the  Bishops  and  Clergy  of 
England  and  Ireland,  and  to  the  churches 
there  committed  to  their  charge,  all  such 
Rights  and  Privileges,  as  by  Law  do,  or  shall 
appertain  to  Them,  or  any  of  Them?  "    After 
this,  laying  her  right  hand  on  the   Holy 
Gospel,  she  said,  "The  things  which  I  have 
here  before  promised,  I  will  perform  and 
keep.     So  help  me  God."     She  kissed  the 
book,   and   signed  the  oath      (Coronation 
Serviee,  &o.,  edited  by  J.  F.  Russell,  1875). 
II.  Oath  of  the  Queen's  supremac3%  &c. : 
ministered  to  those  to  be  ordained  priests  or 
deacons,  or  consecrated  bishops  (See  Supre- 


536 


OBADIAH 


macy).  By  the  Clergy  Subscription  Act, 
1865,  28  &  29  Vict.  c.  cxxii.,  oaths  are  not 
to  be  administered  during  the  services  of 
ordination,  and  a  new  form  of  subscription 
was  enacted,  and  afterwards  the  canons 
were  altered  accordingly. 

III.  At  the  consecration  of  a  bishop  an 
oath  of  obedience  from  the  bishop  elect  to  the 
archbishop  is  ministered,  in  the  words  "  I, 
N,  chosen  Bishop  of  the  Church  and  See  of 
N,  do  profess  and  promise  all  due  reverence 
and  obedience  to  the  Archbishop,  and  to  the 
Metropolitical  Church  of  JSf,  and  tO'  their 
successors :  So  help  me  God,  through  Jesus 
Christ." 

This  is  taken  from  the  Sarum  Pontifical, 
and  occurs  with  slight  variations  in  the 
Winton  and  Bangor  Pontificals.  In  the 
Roman  Pontifical,  the  oath  of  obedience  is 
here  made  to  the  Pope  (Catal.  i.  178). 

IV.  "  As  we  confess  that  vain  and  rash 
swearing  is  forbidden  Christian  men  by  our 
Lord  Jesus  Christ,  and  James  his  apostle, 
BO  we  judge  that  the  Christian  religion  doth 
not  prohibit,  but  that  a  man  may  swear 
when  the  magistrate  requireth,  in  a  cause 
of  faith  and  charity,  so  it  be  done  according 
to  the  prophet's  teaching,  in  justice,  judg- 
ment, and  truth." — Article  xxxix.  The  first 
oath  mentioned  in  the  Holy  Scriptures  is 
that  of  Abraham,  Gen.  xiv.  22,  23.    [H.] 

OBADIAH,  THE  PROPHECY  OP.  A 
canonical  book  of  the  Old  Testament.  The 
time  when  this  prophecy  was  delivered  is 
wholly  uncertain.  The  Hebrews  believe 
that  this  prophet  was  the  same  ^vith  the 
governor  of  Ahab's  house,  mentioned  in  the 
Pirst  Book  of  Kings,  who  hid  and  fed  the 
hundred  prophets,  whom  Jezebel  would 
have  destroyed.  Some  say  he  was  that 
Obadiah  whom  Josiah  made  overseer  of  the 
works  of  the  temple.  But  most  writers 
make  him  contemporary  with  Hosea,  Amos, 
and  Joel  (See  Speaker's  Commerdary). 

OBIIT,  or  OBIT.  An  office  performed  at 
funerals,  when  the  corpse  was  in  the  church 
before  it  was  buried;  it  afterwards  came  to 
be  performed  on  the  anniversary  of  the  death 
of  a  benefactor.  Thus,  in  many  of  our 
colleges,  the  ohiit  or  anniversary  of  the  death 
of  the  formder  is  piously  observed  (See 
Commemoration).  The  ohiit  Sundays  (once 
a  quarter)  at  St.  George's  at  Windsor,  were 
celebrated  formerly  with  great  magnificence, 
and  are  to  a  certain  degree  still.  In  Ken- 
net's  Register,  p.  765  (as  quoted  in  the 
Hierurgia  Anglicana,  p.  211),  there  is  the 
following  notice  :  "  1662,  Sept.  10.— This 
day  was  published  the  service  that  is  per- 
foTned  iu  the  King's  Free  Chapel  of  St. 
George,  in  the  castle  of  Windsor,  upon  Obit 
Sunday  in  the  morning  (that  is,  the  Sunday 
before  every  quarter  day),  and  at  the  offer- 
ing up  of  the  achievements  of  the  deceased 


OBLATIONS 

Knights  of  the  Garter.  The  offices  for 
"Obiits"  are  given  in  Blunt's  Annotated 
Prayer  Book,  ii.  802. 

OBJECTIVE  :  belonging  to,  or  contained 
in  the  object.  A  term  much  used  in  scho- 
lastic theology.  "  Certainty  is  distinguished 
into  objective  and  subjective;  objective  is 
when  the  proposition  is  certainly  true  of 
itself;  subjective  is  when  we  are  certain  of 
the  truth  of  it  "  {fVatts).  Applying  the 
terms,  for  example  to  worship,  objective 
worship  is  the  adoration  of  God  without  re- 
ference to  the  person  adoring  ;  subjective  wor- 
ship is  that  offered  for  the  advantage  of  the 
subject,  that  is  to  say,  the  person  offering  it. — 
Hamilton's  Reid's  Works,  notes  in  fin.  [H.] 

OBLATIONS  (oblationes,  munera, 
TTpoa-^iopai,  SSipa).  Offerings  to  God.  I.  In 
the  mder  sense  of  the  word  by  oblations  is 
meant  anything  offered  to  God  and  His 
Church,  whether  iu  lands  or  goods.  With- 
out referring  to  the  gifts  or  ahns  which  were 
customary  among  the  Jews  (see  Alms')  it  is 
only  necessary  to  point  out  what  St.  Paul 
says  on  the  subject,  when  writing  to  the 
Corinthians  and  Galatians,  and  through 
them  to  the  Christian  communities  generally. 
He  urges  that  aU  should  yield  something  to 
God  for  the  saints  every  Lord's  day  (1  Cor. 
xvi.  2 ;  Gal.  ii.  10).  Prom  a  passage  in  Ter- 
tuUian  (Apol.  c.  39)  it  would  seem  that  the 
weekly  offering  was  considered  too  frequent, 
and  a  monthly  collection  was  what  was  re- 
commended. But  probably  he  refers  '  to 
charitable  collections  as  distinct  from  the 
ecclesiastical  offerings,  which  were  weekly 
(Dodgson's  Trans.).  The  oblations  were 
certainly  to  be  voluntary  "  nemo  compellitur, 
sed  sponte  offert."  Justin  Martyr  {Apol.  i.  69) 
speaks  of  all  giving  as  they  were  disposed : 
the  fund  being  deposited  with  the  president, 
or  perhaps  bishop  (jvpoea-Tus),  who  was 
the  curator  of  all  in  need.  St.  Cyprian 
speaks  of  the  necessity  of  offering  something 
for  the  poor  (de  Oper.  et  Eleemos.),  and  St. 
Augustine  says  that  "  a  man  of  ability " 
(idoneus)  ought  "  to  be  ashamed  of  another 
man's  oblations  ; "  and  therefore  he  exhorts 
everyone  to  bring  their  own  oblations  to  be 
consecrated  at  the  altar,  though  they  would 
not  be  offered  on  the  altar  (Bingham,  Ant. 
XV.  ii.).  It  was  always  the  custom  for  com- 
municants to  offer  something  at  receiving 
the  Sacrament,  as  well  for  holy  uses,  as  for 
the  relief  of  the  poor,  or  other  good  pur- 
poses. In  the  first  ages  of  the  Church, 
those  deposita  pietatis,  which  are  mentioned 
by  the  early  writers,  were  all  voluntary 
oblations,  and  they  were  received  in  hen  of 
tithes ;  for  the  Christians  at  that  time  lived 
chiefly  in  cities,  and  gave  out  of  their  com- 
mon stock,  both  to  maintain  the  church,  and 
those  who  served  at  the  altar. 

But  when  their  numbers  increased,  and 


OBLATIONS 

they  were  spread  abroad  in  the  countries, 
tlien  a  more  fixed  maintenance  was  necessary 
for  the  clergy ;  but  still  oblations  were  made 
by  the  people,  of  which,  if  offered  in  the 
mother  church,  the  bishop  sometimes  had 
half,  and  the  other  was  divided  amongst  the 
clergy ;  but  if  offered  in  a  parish  church,  the 
bishop  had  a  third  part,  and  no  more.  But 
there  was  no  rule  with  regard  to  this,  and 
indeed  the  division  in  that  way  was  after- 
wards reprobated  (Du  Pin,  cent.  9,  p.  113). 
These  oblations,  which  at  first  were  volun- 
tary, became  afterwards,  by  a  continual 
payment,  due  by  custom. 

It  is  true  there  are  canons  which  require 
every  one  who  approaches  the  altar  to  make 
some  oblation  to  it,  as  a  thing  convenient  to 
be  done.  And  it  is  probable  that,  in  obedience 
to  the  canons,  it  became  customary  for  every 
man  who  made  a  will  (before  the  Eeforma- 
tion)  to  devise  something  to  the  high  altar 
of  the  church  where  he  hved,  and  some- 
thing likewise  to  the  mother  church  or 
cathedral;  and  those  who  were  to  be  buried 
in  the  (church  usually  gave  something  to- 
wards its  reparations. 

But  at  the  great  festivals  all  people  were 
expected  to  offer  something,  not  only  as 
convenient,  but  as  a  duty ;  but  the  propor- 
tion was  left  to  the  discretion  of  the  giver. 
The  bounty  of  the  Christians  in  early  ages 
was  so  great,  that  men  would  build  churches 
on  their  own  lands,  but  often,  it  may  be 
supposed,  with  the  purpose  that  they  might 
have  an  equal  share  of  those  oblations  with 
the  clergy. 

And  this  might  be  the  occasion  that 
the  emperors  Constantine  and  Valentinian 
made  laws  to  prohibit  such  excessive  gifts, 
which  in  those  days  were  kept  in  store- 
houses built  for  that  very  purpose. 

But  in  succeeding  ages  there  was  little 
occasion  for  such  laws,  for  the  zeal  of  the 
people  was  so  much  abated,  that,  instead  of 
those  repositories,  the  clergy  had  little  chests 
to  contain  those  gifts,  till  at  last  they 
dwindled  into  so  small  a  portion,  that  now,  as 
a  quaint  writer  obsei-ves,  they  can  scarce  be 
lelt  in  the  parson's  pocket. 

II.  The  word  oblations  may  be  illustrated 
from  the  coronation  service  of  Queen  Victoria. 
Her  "first  oblation"  was  a  pall  or  altar- 
cloth  of  gold,  and  an  ingot  of  gold :  the  next 
fi  sword :  and  afterwards  at  the  offertory 
were  two  "oblations";  the  first  being  hread 
and  wine  for  the  Communion,  which  were 
"  by  the  archbishop  received  from  the  queen 
(who  was  kneeling),  and  reverently  placed 
upon  the  altar,  and  decently  covered  with  a 
fine  linen  cloth :  "  with  a  prayer,  "  Bless,  O 
Lord,  we  beseech  Thee,  these  Thy  gifts,  and 
sanctify  them  unto  their  holy  use,"  &c. 
■"  Then  the  queen,  kneeling  as  before,  makes 
ier  second  oblation,  a  purse  of  gold ; "  and 


OBLATIONS 


537 


then  follows  a  prayer  to  God  "to  receive 
these  oblations  "  (Maskell's  Mon.  Bit.  ii. ; 
Eussell's  Coronation  Service). 

III.  It  was  in  the  primitive  times,  and  up 
to  1552,  required  tliat  bread  and  wme, 
mixed  with  water,  should  form  part  of  the 
people's  oblations  (Iren.  adv.  Exr.  iv.  18, 
&c. ;  Apost.  Can.  3),  and  these  only  were 
offered  on  the  altar,  or  in  the  sanctuary. 
"It  is  not  lawful,"  says  an  early  canon, 
"  for  anything  to  he  offered  in  the  sanctuary, 
but  bread  and  wine  and  water"  {Cone. 
Garth,  a.d.  397 ;  Cone.  Hard.  iii.  397). 
And  this  rule  was  observed  afterwards  (  Ordo 
Rom.  ii.  6).  As  long  as  the  customary 
oblations  of  the  people  contained  the  "  bread, 
and  wine  and  water,"  the  eucharistic  elements 
were  selected  from  them,  the  wine  always 
being  mixed  ivith  water  ■ — to  K^Kpanivov 
TTOTTjpwv  (Iren.  v.  c.  2 :  Just.  Mart.  Apol.  1) 
— and  the  bread,  that  commonly  used  (see 
Mixed  Chalice,  Water).  Bona  conjectures  that 
when  the  people  discontinued  offering  bread, 
it  became  the  duty  of  the  clergy  to  provide 
the  bread  for  the  Eucharist,  and  they  used 
tmleavened  bread  {Rer.  Lit.  i.  xxiii.  n.  11). 
At  the  present  time,  in  the  English  Church, 
the  bread  and  wine  are  ordered  to  be  pro- 
vided by  the  churchwardens,  without  any  re- 
ference to  the  oblations  of  the  people.    [II.] 

IV.  The  word  "  oblation "  occurs  only 
once  in  the  Prayer  Book — i.e.  in  the  prayer 
for  the  Church  Militant.  In  the  first  Prayer 
Book  of  Edward  VI..,  1549,  the  joriest  was 
ordered  in  this  place  to  set  the  bread  and 
wine  upon  the  altar.  The  words  "  and  ob- 
lations" were  inserted  in  1662,  when  also 
it  was  directed  that  the  priest  "  shall  then 
place  upon  the  table  so  much  bread  and 
wine,  as  he  shall  think  sufficient."  In  the 
Prayer  Books  of  1552  and  1559  there  was 
no  direction  for  putting  either  the  alms  or 
the  elements  on  the  table ;  and  the  Church 
Militant  prayer  and  the  whole  service  was 
silent  about  oblations,  and  the  rubric  be- 
fore it  directed  "  the  churchwardens  to 
collect  the  devotions  of  the  people."  Nor 
was  there  anything  materially  different  in  the 
(unauthorized)  Prayer  Book  put  forth  by 
James  I.  in  1604.  In  1661  the  rubric  was 
changed  to  directing  "  the  alms  and  other  de- 
votions of  the  people  "  to  be  collected  during 
the  offertory  sentences,  and  to  be  laid  on  the 
Table ;  and  then  again,  as  in  1549  substan- 
tially, the  priest  was  directed  at  that  point 
to  "  place  the  bread  and  wine  on  the  table  " 
also.  And  then  the  word  "oblations"  was 
added  after  "  alms,"  with  the  rubrical  note, 
"if  there  be  no  alms  or  oblations,"  &o.  Bishop 
Patrick  argued  from  this  last  alteration  only 
that  by  "  oblations  "  are  to  be  understood  the 
elements  (see  Elements).  It  is  also  argued 
that  "  alms  and  oblations  "  in  the  prayer  and 
its  rubrical  note  evidently  relate  to  the  "  alms 


538 


OBLATIONS 


and  other  devotions  of  the  people"  in  the 
oifertory  rubric.  It  is  remarkable  that  Laud's 
Scotch  Prayer  Book  of  1637  did  contain  the 
■words,  which  he  did  not  venture  to  intro- 
duce into  the  Enghsh  one,  "  The  Presbyter 
shaU  then  offer  up  and  place  the  bread  and 
■wine  upon  the  Lord's  table."  From  these 
facts  readers  must  dra^w  their  own  conclu- 
sions whether  "oblations"  in  the  Church 
Militant  prayer  mean  any  special  devotions 
of  the  people,  or  the  elements  which  are 
not  offered  by  the  people,  but  provided  by 
the  churchwardens  in  obedience  to  the 
law. 

The  Latin  Prayer  Book  which  was  pre- 
pared by  royal  authority  soon  after  the 
authorised  one  of  1662,  for  use  in  the 
universities  and  other  cliurches  where  the 
Latin  service  might  be  used  under  the  Act 
of  Unilbrmity,  is  decisive  on  this  point,  and 
the  more  so  because  it  was  done  by  what 
may  be  called  a  succession  of  High  Church- 
men and  under  the  influence  of  Archbishop 
Sancroft,  a  nonjuror.  They  were  Earle, 
Bishop  of  Salisbury  (omitting  their  previous 
dignities),  Pearson,  Bishop  of  Chester,  Arch- 
bishop Dolben,  and  Dr.  Durel,  Dean  of 
Windsor,  who  finished  it  for  publication  in 
1670.  An  account  of  that  book  was  pub- 
lished in  1882  by  the  Eev.  C.  Marshall, 
containing  a  good  deal  of  other  history  ol 
the  rubrics  on  this  point,  too  long  to  use 
here.  Seven  editions  of  it  appear  to  have  been 
issued  before  1704,  but  they  are  very  scarce, 
even  in  great  libraries,  and  some  of  those 
few  copies  somehow  want  the  Catechism, 
■n'hich  accordingly  Marshall  reprinted.  Sun- 
dry other  versions  were  afterwards  made, 
without  authority ;  and  Bagster's,  in  his 
Polyglot  series,  in  1821,  seems  to  have  been 
compiled  from  all  of  them ;  and  so  was 
another,  by  J.  W.  Parker  (Oxford)  in  1848. 
Canons  Bright  and  Medd  made  a  new  one, 
somewhat  different  from  all  the  old  ones  in 
some  important  points,  in  1867.  'J'he  Latin 
version  of  the  rubric  for  Oblations  before 
the  Church  Militant  prayer  has  ohlationes 
in  pios  usus,  for  the  English  "  other  devo- 
tions of  the  people,"  which  is  decisive  as  to 
the  meaning  of  oblations  therein.  And  it 
is  clear  from  sundry  other  facts  in  the  his- 
tory, including  Laud's  Scotch  Prayer  Book 
of  1637,  which  directs  the  oblations  to  be 
brought  in  the  bason,  that  the  idea  of 
oblations  meaning  or  including  the  Ele- 
ments was  entertained  by  nobody  at  that 
time,  or  till  long  afterwards.  Moreover, 
in  Elizabeth's  Latin  Prayer  Book,  and  in 
James  L's  (which  is  valuable  as  an  in- 
terpretation, both  before  and  after  1662),  the 
rubric  at  the  end  of  the  service  gives 
" decimas,  ohlationes,  cmteraqice  debita"  as 
the  equivalent  for  "ecclesiastical  duties;" 
and  the  whole  history  shows  that  "  alms " 


OCCASIONAL  PEAYEKS 

meant  gifts  expressly  for  the  poor,  and 
"  oblations "  gifts  in  pios  usus  generally^ 
and  particularly  for  the  clergy. 

This  Latin  version,  adding  in  pios  usus- 
as  an  explanation  of  the  meaning  of  obla- 
tions, also  proves  the  lawfulness  of  using 
the  offertory  for  some  special  object  and  not 
merely  as  alms  for  the  poor';  and  it  is 
evident  that  the  object  must  be  declared 
beforehand  by  the  minister,  or  else  writter. 
down  by  each  donor,  which  would  be  im- 
practicable. This  version  is  the  more  valu- 
able as  a  contemporanea  expositio  of  the 
meaning  of  "  oblations,"  because  it  was  lor 
the  special  use  of  the  clergy  in  their  Convoca- 
tions and  the  Universities,  who  could  judge  of 
its  accuracy  better  than  anybody  else.  None 
of  the  later  ones  have  had  that  value.    [G.] 

OBSECRATIONS.  Prayers  for  deliverance 
from  sin  and  its  consequences,  based  upon 
the  successive  steps  in  the  work  of  Redemp- 
tion, from  the  Incarnation  to  the  Ascension 
and  the  Bestowal  of  the  Holy  Ghost.  They 
imply  that  each  act  in  our  Blessed  Lord's 
life  has  a  special  saving  virtue  of  its  own.. 
The  Litany  is  usually  divided  into  invo- 
cations, deprecations,  obsecrations,  interces- 
sions, versicles  and  prayers.  The  obsecra- 
tions begin  at  the  eleventh  petition  of  our 
Litany.  The  expressions  used  must  appeal 
to  every  heart,  yet  John  Knox  called  these 
"  a  certain  conjuring  of  God,"  and  branded 
them  as  Popish !     [H.] 

OBSEQUIES  (Lat.  ohsequium,  com- 
plaisance, from  ohsequi,  to  follow;  also 
called  exequies').  Funeral  rites  and  solem- 
nities. Donatus  thus  explains  the  word: 
"  Quia  mortuus  prajibat,  casteri  seque- 
bantur  in  funere."  Durandus  gives  this 
more  remote  explanation :  "  Quia  celebran- 
tur,  dum  mortui  extra  vivos  sepeliundi  fei- 
untur;  vel  quia  extra  boras  canonicas 
speciales,  et  singulares  habent  observantias  " 
(lib.  7,  c.  35).  The  simpler  explanation  is 
that  apparently  accepted  by  Milton : 

**  Him  I'll  solemnly  attend 
■With  silent  obsequy,  and  funeral  train." 

(See  Burial).  [H.] 
OCCASIONAL  PRAYERS.  These  were 
appended  to  the  morning  and  evening  prayer 
in  1661,  but  some  of  the  prayers  had  been 
in  use  at  an  earlier  date.  The  prayers  foir 
rain,  and  for  fair  -weather,  were  inserted  in 
the  Prayer  Book  of  1549  at  the  end  of  the 
Communion  service.  In  the  Prayer  Book 
of  1552  these,  with  four  other  "  occasional " 
prayers,  were  placed  at  the  end  of  the  Litany, 
before  the  prayer  of  St.  Chrysostom.  These 
were  two  for  "  Time  of  Dearth  ; "  one  "  In 
time  of  War,"  and  one  "  In  time  of  Plague 
or  Sickness."  It  is  interesting  to  note  with 
regard  to  the  addition  of  this  latter  prayer, 
that  there  was  an  epidemic  of  sweating  sick- 
ness, and  dearth,  in   1551   (Strype,  Mem. 


OCTAVE 

Ecd.  vi.  bk.  ii.  c.  iv.).  Thanksgivings  cor- 
responding to  these  were  added  in  160i-,  the 
other  additions,  both  of  prayers  and  thanks- 
givings, were  made  in  1661.  They  are 
generally  original  compositions,  but  based 
on  ancient  models.  The  collect,  for  instance, 
for  ."Fine  Weather"  is  an  expansion  of  one 
in  the  Gregorian  Sacramentary.  The 
prayer  that  "may  be  said  after  any  of 
the  former"  is  also  taken  from  the  Gre- 
gorian Sacramentary.  It  was  in  the  Salis- 
bury Use,  and  in  all  the  Prymers  of  the 
English  Church.  The  mediasval  form  was 
— "  Preie  we.  Orisoun.  Deus  cui  proprium. 
God  to  whom  it  is  propre  to  be  merciful 
and  to  spare  evermore,  undirfonge  (i.e.  im- 
dertafce)  ourc  preieris:  and  the  merciful- 
nesse  of  Thi  pitie  asoile  hem,  that  the 
chayne  of  trespas  bindith.  Bi  Crist  cure 
Lord.  So  be  it." — Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  ii.  107 ; 
Palmer,  Orig.  Liturg.  i.  p.  306.     [H.] 

OCTAVE.  The  octave  is  the  eighth  day 
after  any  principal  festival  of  the  Church. 
In  ancient  times  it  was  customary  to  ob- 
sei-ve  these  days  with  much  devotion,  in- 
cluding the  whole  period  also  from  the 
festival  to  the  octave.  It  was  thought 
that  the  subject  and  occasion  of  these  high 
festivals  called  for  their  being  lengthened 
out  in  this  manner ;  and  the  period  of  eight 
days  was  chosen  because  the  Jews  celebrated 
their  greater  feasts,  some  for  seven  days,  and 
the  Feast  of  Tabernacles  for  eight  days. 
Such  Jewish  institutions  being  only  types 
and  shadows,  the  Christians  thought  it  fit 
not  to  have  their  commemorations  of  shorter 
duration. 

In  our  Prayer  Book  we  retain  the  obser- 
vance of  the  octaves  of  Christmas,  Easter, 
Ascension,  and  Whitsunday,  by  using,  for 
seven  days  after  each  of  these  festivals,  an 
appropriate  "Preface,"  in  the  Communion 
Service,  if  that  sacrament  is  administered 
on  any  of  these  days.  The  preface  for  Whit- 
sunday is,  however,  only  to  be  used  for  six 
days  after,  because  the  seventh  (or  octave 
of  Whitsunday)  would  be  Trinity  Sunday, 
which  has  a  preface  of  its  own. 

The  first  two  days  of  the  octaves  of  Easter 
and  Whitsunday  have  special  services,  and 
in  some  cathedrals  and  churches  are  observed 
with  nearly  the  same  solemnity  as  the  festival 
itself.  It  appears  by  the  Pietas  Londinensis, 
published  in  1714,  that  in  the  church  of  St. 
Dunstan  in  the  West,  the  Holy  Communion 
was  administered  on  every  day  during  the 
octaves  of  Christmas,  Easter,  and  Whitsun- 
tide. But  this  was  not  an  exceptional  case. 
At  the  present  time  the  octaves  of  the  great 
festivals  are  frequently  observed,  and  also 
those  of  the  particular  dedication  of  the 
churches.  There  is,  however,  no  rule  with 
regard  to  such  observances ;  it  is  left  to  the 
discretion  of  the  ministers. 


OFFBRTOEY 


539- 


ffiCUMENICAL  {oiKoviKviKos).  I.  The 
word  was  applied  by  the  Komans  to  im- 
ply all  the  people  contained  in  the  empire. 
In  the  Septuagint  and  in  the  Now  Testa- 
ment it  is  used  for  the  whole  inhabited 
earth.  The  councils  at  which  the  bishops 
from  all  parts  of  the  world  attended  are 
called  "oecumenical,"  and  those  acknow- 
ledged under  this  title  are  the  Councils  (1) 
of  Nicasa,  a.d.  325 ;  (2)  of  Constantinople, 
A.D.  381 ;  (3)  of  Ephesus,  a.d.  431 ;  (4)  of 
Chalcedon,  a.d.  451 ;  (5  and  6)  the  2nd  and 
3rd  of  Constantinople,  a.d.  553  and  680 ; 
and  (7)  the  2nd  of  Nicaja,  a.d.  787  (See 
Councils).  II.  To  the  patriarch  of  Con- 
stantinople the  title  of  oecumenical  or  uni- 
versal patriarch  was  at  one  time  given 
(Just.  Novel.  7,  16,  42).     [H.] 

OFFERING  DAYS.  The  four  general 
offering  days  were  Christmas  Day,  Easter 
Day,  Whitsunday,  and  the  feast  of  the 
dedication  of  the  parish  church.  By  an  Act 
passed  in  1536  Midsummer  and  Michaelmas 
were  substituted  for  the  two  latter  days. 
The  offerings  were  for  the  curate.  This 
custom  is  now  rarely  observed,  but  it  used 
to  be  the  case  that  the  king  and  queen  in 
their  chapel  royal,  or  wherever  they  were  at 
church  on  those  days,  never  omitted  it,  but 
arose  from  their  seat  and  went  in  solemn 
manner  to  present  their  offering  upon  their 
knees  at  God's  altar.  And  then  was  read 
by  the  priest  or  bishop  attending,  the  sen- 
tence here  prescribed,  1  Cor.  ix.  13. 

OFFERTORy.  I'hat  part  of  the  com- 
munion service  in  which  the  offerings  are 
made.  The  custom  of  making  an  offering 
at  the  communion  is  certainly  apostolical, 
as  appears  from  1  Cor.  xvi.  2  :  "On  the  first 
day  of  the  week  let  every  one  lay  by  him 
in  store  as  God  hath  prospered  him."  Which 
custom  continued  down  to  the  following 
ages,  as  appears  from  different  passages  in 
Justin  Martyr,  TertuUian,  St.  Cyprian,  St. 
Ambrose,  St.  Chrysostom,  and  other  ancient 
writers  (See  Elements,  Oblations).  In  the 
Prayer  Book  of  1549  the  people  are  directed 
to  come  and  offer  unto  the  poor  men's  box, 
and  to  make  their  accustomed  offerings  to 
the  curate.  In  1552  the  rubric  was,  "  then 
shall  the  churchwardens,  or  some  other  by 
them  appointed,  gather  the  devotion  of  the 
people,  and  put  the  same  into  the  poor 
men's  box:  and  upon  the  offering  days 
appointed  (see  Offering  Bays)  every  man 
and  woman  .shall  pay  to  the  curate  the  due 
and  accustomed  offerings."  The  present 
rubric  was  added  in  1661.  It  is  a  modifi- 
cation of  one  proposed  by  Bishop  Cosin, 
whichran,  "after  the  Divine  service  ended, 
the  money  shall  be  divided,  one  half  to  the 
priest  [to  provide  the  iooJcs  of  divinity 
(erased)],  the  other  half  to  be  employed  to 
some  pious  or  charitable  use  for  the  decent 


540 


OFFICE 


furnishing  of  tlie  churcli,  or  tlie  relief  of  the 
poor  at  the  discretion  of  the  priest  and 
churchwardens,  or  other  ofiicers  of  the  place 
that  are  for  that  purpose  appointed  "  (Mas- 
kell,  Anc.  Lit.  53  seq. ;  Blunt's  Parish 
Friest,  p.  332  ;  Annot.  P.  B.  ii.  199). 

II.  OFFERTORY,  Sei-vice  of.  (Cantus 
offertorii ;  antiphona  ad  offertorium  ;  offer- 
«nda).  A  service  of  song  while  the  oblations 
were  collected  and  received.  This  is  of  ancient 
date.  St.  Augustine  speaks  of  the  singing 
of  hymns  at  the  oblation,  both  before  the 
collection  and  when  the  offerings  were  being 
distributed  to  the  people,  and  he  says  that 
■this  custom  sprang  up  at  Carthage  {Retract. 
11).  The  word  offertorium  seems  to  have 
■been  first  used  by  Isidore  a.d.  595,  when 
he  says,  "Offertoria  quje  in  sacrificiorum 
honore  canuntur  "  (Be  Off.  i.  161).  There 
were  no  doubt  different  usages  in  different 
•churches.  At  Milan,  where  music  was  much 
•cultivated,  the  offertoria,  or  offerenda  were 
very  solemnly  sung  (Martene,  de  Ant.  Ecc. 
Pit.  i.  iv.  xii.  ord.  3).  The  second  "  Ordo 
Eomanus,"  a.d.  800,  prescribes  that  the 
•"  offertorium "  should  be  sung  with  verses 
^Mus.  Ital.  ii.  46,  47).  The  offertory  sung 
during  the  offering  is  frequently  referred  to 
in  later  works  (Murat.  Liturg.  Bom.  Vit. 
ii.  1).  Before  the  Reformation  a  short 
anthem,  called  the  offertorium,  was  sung  at 
the  time  of  collection,  with  a  prayer  follow- 
ing. In  the  "Uses"  of  Sarum  and  York 
the  rubric  is  "  deinde  dioitur  offertorium  "  ; 
in  that  of  Hereford,  "  Sacerdos — canat  cum 
suis  ministris  offertorium"  (Miss.  Ehor. 
fol.  73 :  Sarum,  72).  The  sentences  at  the 
offertory  are  set  to  varied  melodies  in  Mar- 
beck's  book,  according  to  the  licence  given 
in  King  Edward  VI.'s  First  Book,  either  to 
sing  or  to  say  them.  This  licence  is  with- 
drawn by  the  rubric  as  it  now  stands,  so 
altered  in  King  Edward's  Second  Book,  since 
the  saying  of  the  sentences  by  the  priest  is 
expressly  enjoined  (Palmer,  Orig.  Lit.  ii. 
V4).  In  many  churches  now,  however,  after 
the  priest  has  acted  according  to  the  rubric 
and  said  one  or  two  sentences,  the  choir 
sing  others — a  practice  which  has  not  yet 
been  declared  illegal.    [H.] 

Some  persons  think  that  there  is  a  dis- 
tinction between  the  money  given  at  the 
■offertory  when  there  is  a  communion,  and 
when  there  is  not,  and  that  it  must  be  all 
given  to  the  poor  when  there  is  one,  but 
not  when  there  is  not.  The  rubric  recog- 
nises no  such  distinction,  but  the  "  other 
■devotions  of  the  people"  are  distinguished 
from  mere  alms  in  the  Church  Militant 
prayer,  and  surely  allow  any  application  of 
them  which  is  announced  beforehand  by 
the  minister,  as  well  as  any  indicated  by 
the  givers.     [G.] 

OFFICE,     from     offkium ;     contracted 


OLD  CATHOLICS 

from  opijkium,  i.e.  opi,  crude  form  of  opes, 
wealth,  also  aid  and  help,  and  facere,  to  do, 
and  so  implies  service  done — an  act  of 
duty  or  worship. 

OFFICES.  Services  offered  before  God. 
In  the  primitive  times  there  were  daily 
offices,  as  may  be  gathered  from  many,  of 
the  earliest  Christian  -writers,  though  no 
account  has  come  to  us  which  tells  exactly 
of  what  they  consisted.  They  were  prob- 
ably in  number  seven,  in  accordance  with 
the  Psalmist's  maxim,  "  Seven  times  a  day 
do  I  praise  Thee"  (Ps.  cxix.  164),  and  this 
was  certainly  the  rule  in  the  4th  century. 
In  the  medisBval  times  these  offices  became 
very  complex,  and  the  Reformers  condensed 
them  into  Morning  and  Evening  SeiTice — 
Matins  or  Evensong  (See  Hours').  But  all 
religious  services  are  offices.    [H.] 

OFFICIAL.  The  oflBcial  is  the  person  to 
whom  cognisance  of  causes  is  committed  by 
such  as  have  an  ecclesiastical  jurisdiction. 
In  early  times  bishops  availed  themselves  of 
assistants,  and  St.  Basil  and  Gregory  were 
so  employed.  About  the  end  of  the  13th 
century,  bishops  frequently  used  vicars- 
general  and  officials.  The  OflS.cial  Principal 
is  the  assistant  of  the  bishop  in  matters  of 
civil  or  criminal  nature,  and  aids  him  in 
points  of  law,  and  to  defend  the  rights  of 
the  church.  'The  official  of  an  archdeacon 
stands  in  like  relation  to  him  as  the  chan- 
cellor does  to  the  bishop. 

OGEE  {Ogive,  French).  An  inflected 
cuiTe;  in  mathematical  language  a  curve 
of  contrary  flexure,  or  one  formed  of  two 
segments  ending  opposite  ways.  This 
curve  occurs  chiefly  in  mouldings,  and  is 
principally  characteristic  of  the  later  styles ; 
but  it  occurs  in  other  styles  also,  and  has 
several  variations  according  to  its  place  and 
date.  The  word  is  used  in  French  as  a 
generic  term  for  pointed  architecture. 

OIL.  A  great  many  superstitions  arose 
in  early  times  with  regard  to  oik  (1)  The 
"oil  of  the  martyrs"  or  "holy  oil"  was 
considered  of  great  efficacy  in  curing  dis- 
eases, and  strengthening  the  weak.  This 
was  supposed  to  flow  from  the  relics  of 
saints  and  martyrs,  from  their  tombs,  from 
their  icons,  and  from  the  lamps  which  burnt 
before  their  shrines  (See  Bict.  of  Christian 
Antiquities,  ii.  1453).  (2)  Oil  was  used  in 
the  case  of  catechumens,  who  were  once  or 
oftener  anointed ;  the  oil  being  called  "  hal- 
lowed," or  "  exorcised" ;  at  baptisms  and  in 
the  case  of  the  sick  (see  Church,  Baptism, 
Extreme  Unction).  I5ut  the  frequent  use 
of  oil  was  altogether  discarded  at  the  Re- 
formation, except  at  coronations,  in  conse- 
quence of  the  superstitious  ideas  thereto 
attached.     [H.] 

OLD  CATHOLICS.  This  term  originated 
in  Germany,  and  it  expresses  the  belief  that 


OLD  CATHOLICS 

the  Catholic  faith,  as  handed  down  from  the 
primitive  times,  may  be  held  -without  forcing 
upon  believers  ideas  engendered  in  modern 
times,  such  as  the  infallibility  of  the  pope,  and 
other  doctrines  which  have  not  any  ancient 
sanction.  Several  writere  of  late  years  have 
dealt  with  this  subject,  but,  it  need  hardly  be 
said,  with  obstinate  opposition  on  the  part  of 
the  Roman  Church.  In  1863  a  conference,  at 
which  about  a  hundred  divines  attended,  was 
held  at  Munich,  under  the  presidency  of  Dr. 
DoUinger.  The  object  was  to  form  a  bond 
of  union  between  the  Catholic  divines  of  Ger- 
many, and  to  illustrate  the  real  harmony 
between  religious  and  scientific  truth.  The 
president's  address  (Die  Vergangenheit  und 
Gegenwart  der  kath.  Theologie)  contained 
an  excellent  sketch  of  the  growth  of  Catholic 
Theology  from  the  Alexandrine  school  of  the 
second  century,  down  to  the  present  day ; 
a  full  summary  of  it  was  given  in  the  Home 
and  Foreign  Beview  for  January  1864.  It 
was  far  too  liberal  for  Home,  and  shortly 
afterwards  a  Papal  Brief  was  sent  to  the 
Archbishop  of  Munich,  denouncing  the 
spirit  of  the  German  theology,  and  asserting 
the  supremacy  of  the  Roman  congregations. 
After  this  came  the  Syllabus,  which. was  the 
work  of  the  Jesuits,  who  for  some  years  have 
been  supreme  at  Rome,  and  had  prepared  a 
definition  of  the  Catholic  faith,  which  would 
dispose  of  all  controversies  by  the  infallible 
arbitrament  of  Home  (Stimmen  aus  Maria 
Loach,  Freiburg  1868-70). 

The  Archbishop  of  Munich  thereupon 
summoned  the  Theological  Faculty  and 
called  upon  them  for  their  adhesion  to  the 
Vatican  decrees.  This  they  refused;  and 
DoUinger  wrote  his  "  Erklarung,"  in  which 
he  re-asserted  his  rejection  of  the  dogma  of 
papal  infallibility,  as  contrary  to  Scripture, 
tradition,  and  the  early  councils.  He  was 
formally  excommunicated  as  Dr.  Friedrich 
had  been  before :  but  the  movement  excited 
the  intensest  interest ;  and  in  accordance 
with  the  custom  of  Rome,  excommunications 
were  poured  forth  wholesale  :  the  last  sacra- 
ments were  refused  to  those  who  had  signed 
an  address  of  sympathy  with  Dr.  DoUinger, 
and  the  parish  priests  were  forbidden  to 
marry  any  who  held  the  obnoxious  views. 
The  Government,  though  appealed  to,  acted 
throughout  in  a  weak  and  indecisive  manner. 

The  next  step  was  the  "Old  Catholic 
Congress"  which  met  at  Munich,  Sept.  22, 
1871.  Deputies  attended  from  every  part 
of  Germany,  and  there  were  representatives 
from  other  European  nations,  and  from 
America.  The  doctrinal  basis  and  scope  of 
the  movement  was  here  definitely  laid  down. 
The  members  protested  against  being  thrust 
out  of  Church  communion,  because  of  their 
ideas  which  were  those  of  the  primitive 
Christians;   they  declared  the  censures  of 


OLD  CATHOLICS 


541 


the  Church  of  Rome  to  be  objectless  and 
arbitrary,  and  ultra  vires  :  they  shewed  that 
Pius  IX.  had  gone  against  the  confession  of 
faith  contained  in  the  Tridentine  Creed; 
they  rejected  the  Infallibility  of  the  Pope,  as 
given  in  the  Vatican  decrees ;  they  declared 
that  a  council  like  the  Vatican  Council  of 
Rome  could  have  no  ceoumenical  authority ; 
that  the  decrees  of  late  councils  must  at  all 
events  be  shown  to  be  not  contrary  to  the 
ancient  councils  ;  they  looked  to  a  reunion 
with  the  Oriental  and  Russian  Churches,  as 
there  was  no  real  ground  for  separation ;  and 
they  hoped  for  a  gradual  understanding  with 
the  Protestant  Episcopal  Churches.  All 
these,  and  other  points  with  regard  to 
clerical  discipline,  were  unanimously  ac- 
cepted. There  was,  however,  a  general 
desire  that  no  schism  should  take  place. 
All  desired  to  be  members  of  that  Catholic 
Church,  in  which  the  Romanists  are  onlj' 
equally  members,  and  have  no  right  to 
dictate  terms  to  others.  In  many  places 
this  Ibroad  and  liberal  spirit  has  been  re- 
cognised. In  Austria  no  difficulty  is  made 
about  giving  the  Sacrament  to  the  "Old 
Catholics,"  and  separate  congregations  have 
not  been  formed.  Dr.  Schulte,  who  presided 
at  the  first  and  the  second  congress,  was  on 
intimate  terms  with  the  Cardinal  Archbishop 
of  Prague.  But  the  idea  was  always  the 
same,  namely,  a  refonn  of  the  Catholic 
Church,  in  her  head,  and  its  members. 
Many  pamphlets  and  books  were  written  by 
such  men  as  Dr.  Michaud,  Professor  Hilgers, 
Reusth,  Langen  and  Knoodt,  who  were 
excommunicated  by  the  Archbishop  of 
Cologne ;  and  above  all.  Dr.  DoUinger,  who 
delivered  at  Munich,  1872,  some  remarkable 
lectures  on  the  "  Reunion  of  the  Churches." 
The  clergy  as  a  rule  were  in  favour  of  the 
"Old  Catholic  movement,"  but  they  were 
held  back  from  expressing  their  opinions 
because  they  are  under  the  power  of  their 
bishops,  and  to  go  against  what  they  decree 
would  imply  deprivation  and  ruin,  in  the 
present  state  of  the  law.  But  the  move- 
ment has,  nevertheless,  gathered  strength, 
and  in  1872,  at  the  Congress  held  at  Cologne, 
the  Archbishop  of  Utrecht  was  present,  and 
several  other  bishops.  Prom  England  the 
Bishops  of  Lincoln  and  Ely  (Wordsworth 
and  Browne)  were  there,  from  America  the 
Bishop  of  Maryland.  Letters  of  sympathy 
were  also  received  from  the  Eastern  Arch- 
bishops, the  Bishop  of  Lichfield  (Selwyn), 
and  many  distinguished  EngUsh  clergymen 
and  laymen,  who  were  unable  to  attend. 
Schulte  was  the  president,  and  in  his  address 
defined  their  standpoint  as  the  "  Catholic 
one."  "  Those,"  he  said,  "  who  do  not  hold 
to  the  ground  of  positive  belief  in  Christian- 
ity, as  contained  in  the  Scriptures,  and  the 
truly  (Ecumenical  Councils,  we  cannot  regard 


542 


OPHITBS 


as  Catholics,  nor  can  they  have  any  active 
participation  in  our  work."  "Catholic 
Unity,"  amidst  general  applause,  was  in- 
sisted on  by  the  Archbishop  of  Utrecht 
(Dr.  Loos).  The  result  of  this  congress  was 
a  great  feeling  in  favour  of  the  propositions 
then  brought  forward.  In  Switzerland, 
Eeinkens  and  Michelis  did  a  great  work. 
Ueinkens  has  since  been  appointed  Mission- 
ary Bishop  for  the  Old  Catholics  of  Germany. 
He  was  consecrated  at  Rotterdam,  1873, 
a,ccording  to  the  Eoman  rite,  but  without 
any  recognition  of  the  Pope's  supremacy. 
This  movement  is  one  which  must  appeal 
to  all  who  have  Catholic  unity  at  their 
hearts,  and  those  who  do  not  recognise  the 
power  of  the  Vatican  dogmas  may  have  some 
grounds  for  the  hope  that  through  this  endea- 
vour may  be  furthered  the  Union  of  Christ- 
endom (Lectures  on  Reunion  of  the  Churches, 
Dollinger ;  Erkldrung  an  den  ErzbiscJiof  von 
MiJmchen,  by  Dollinger ;  Die  papstlichen 
Dekrete,  by  Eeinkens,  1871 ;  Das  Vatican- 
Dogma,  by  Langen,  Bonn,  ]  871 ;  Lord 
Acton's  Sendschreiben  an  einen  deufschen 
Bischof  Nordlingen,  1870 ;  Home  and  Fo- 
reign Review,  1864  ;  British  Review,  1870 ; 
Theological  Review,  1872 ;  Blunt's  Diet, 
of  Sects,  394).     [H.] 

OPHITES  (from  o(j)is,  a  serpent) ;  also 
called  Serpentinians.  A  ridiculous  sect  of 
heretics,  who  had  for  their  leader  a  man 
called  Euphrates.  They  entertained  al- 
most the  same  fantastic  opinions  that  were 
held  by  the  other  Egyptian  Gnostics  (See 
Gnostics').  But  besides  these,  they  main- 
tained the  following  particular  tenet  (whence 
they  received  the  name  of  Ophites) :  "  That 
the  Serpent  by  which  our  first  parents  were 
deceived,  was  either  Christ  himself,  or 
Sophia  \_Wisdoni],  concealed  under  the 
form  of  that  animal ; "  and  in  consequence 
of  this  opinion  they  are  said  to  have 
nourished  a  certain  number  of  serpents, 
which  they  looked  upon  as  sacred,  and  to 
which  they  offered  a  sort  of  worship,  a 
subordinate  kind  of  divine  honours.  Origen 
gives  some  account  of  them,  but  calls  them 
an  "  obscure  sect "  (contr.  Cels.  iii.  13 :  vi. 
24,  28,  33).  There  is  some  curious  infor- 
mation about  the  Ophites  in  the  lately  dis- 
covered work  of  Hippolytus  (Hippol.  Refut. 
V.  6)  ;  Hose's  Neander,  ii.  101. 

OPTION.  An  archbishop  had  the  choice 
or  option  of  any  one  dignity  or  benefice  in 
the  gift  of  every  bishop  consecrated  or  con- 
firmed by  him,  which  he  might  confer  as 
he  pleased.  This  was  styled  his  option. 
The  privilege  has  been  relinquished  by 
English  archbishops  since  1845,  in  conse- 
quence of  a  construction  put  on  some  words 
in  the  Cathedral  Act  (3  &  4  Vict.  c.  113, 
sect.  42).  "  That  it  shall  not  be  lawful  for 
any  spiritual  person  to  sell  or  assign  any 


OEATOEIO 

patronage  or  presentation  belonging  to  him 
by  virtue  of  any  dignity  or  spiritual  ofBce 
held  by  him." 

An  archbishop's  options  during  the  life 
of  the  bishops  who  had  given  them  were 
his  personal  property,  and  went  to  his  ex- 
ecutors, and  were  once  sold  by  auction. 

OPUS  OPBEATUM.  An  expression  fre- 
quently occurring  in  discussions  respecting 
the  efficacy  of  the  sacraments,  &c.,  import- 
ing a  necessary  spiritual  effect  flowing  from 
tlie  outward  administration  (from  the  thing 
done),  irrespective  of  the  moral  qualities  of 
the  recipient.  This  doctrine  is  alleged  as 
one  of  the  corruptions  of  the  Church  of 
Eome,  and,  if  earned  out,  would  obviously 
equalize,  in  a  great  measure,  the  benefits 
received  by  the  worthy  and  the  unworthy 
who  appi'oach  the  altar,  and  would  justify 
the  administration  of  baptism  to  the  heathen, 
&c.,  not  only  on  consent,  but  by  the  appli- 
cation of  physical  force. 

In  a  certain  sense  it  is  unquestionably 
true  that  all  the  appointed  means  of  grace 
have  an  effect  ex  opere  operate,  inasmuch  as 
the  act  itself,  though  inefficacious  in  its 
own  nature,  is  an  institution  of  God,  and 
consecrated  by  Him  as  an  instrument  not  to 
be  made  void  at  the  caprice  of  man.  Thus, 
the  preaching  of  the  gospel  is  inevitably  a 
savour  of  life  or  of  death.  The  administra- 
tion of  baptism  is  invariably  an  admission 
into  the  Church.  But  that  the  use  of  an 
appointed  ordinance  goes  beyond  this,  and 
results  in  all  cases  in  a  moral  effect  on  the 
individual,  and  in  the  insuring  of  higher 
portions  of  Divine  grace,  ex  necessitate,  is 
contrary  to  the  views  of  the  Church,  the 
doctrine  of  Scripture,  and  the  preservation 
of  man's  free  agency. 

OEAEIUM    (See  Stole). 

OEATORIO.  A  musical  composition 
consisting  of  several  parts,  of  which  the 
subject  is  always  sacred,  and  intended  to  be 
performed  in  a  church.  The  origin  of  this 
kind  of  spiritual  and  musical  composition, 
which  has  now  become  much  developed,  is 
found  in  the  plan  of  Filippo  Neri,  in  the 
early  part  of  the  sixteenth  century,  to  arrest 
the  attention  of  those  to  whom  he  preached, 
by  procuring  the  execution  of  pieces  of 
sacred  music  of  more  than  common  interest 
before  and  after  his  sermon.  This  custom, 
which  commenced  in  the  congregation  of 
the  Oratory  (whence  the  name  Oratorio), 
was  imitated  by  all  the  societies  of  the  same 
foundation,  and  soon  became  so  popular  that 
the  best  masters,  both  in  composition  and  in 
execution,  were  found  to  take  a  part  in  it. 
The  performance  in  the  time  of  Pihppo  Neri 
himself  was  scarcely  more  than  a  cantata, 
and  afterwards  in  some  places  degenerated 
into  a  musical  drama,  accompanied  with 
action  and  scenic  representation,  so  as  to 


ORATORY 

present  much  of  the  character  of  a  musical 
m.ystery  (See  Moralities).  But  it  was 
also  the  forerunner  of  the  modern  oratorio — 
the  suhlime  compositions  of  Bach  and 
Handel,  and  those  who  have  followed  in 
their  steps.  In  England  the  first  oratorio 
produced  was  Handel's  "Esther,"  which 
was  composed  (the  words  heing  abridged 
from  Racine's  tragedy)  for  the  Duke  of 
■Chandos's  chapel  at  Cannons,  and  there 
performed  in  1720 ;  but  that  which  has  ever 
been  the  most  esteemed  is  the  "  Messiah," 
which  was  at  first  rejected  in  London,  and 
brought  out  at  Dublin.  In  the  present  age 
of  music  oratorios  are  performed  frequently 
in  some  cathedrals  and  other  churches,  St. 
Paul's  Cathedral  having  set  a  good  example. 
Those  most  frequently  chosen  are  Bach's 
Passion  music,  Handel's  "  Messiah,"  Men- 
delssohn's "Elijah,"  and  "  St.  Paul,"  &c. 

ORATORY  (Oratorium).  A  name  given 
by  Christians  to  certain  places  of  religious 
worship. 

In  ecclesiastical  antiquity,  the  term 
houses  of  prayer,  or  oratories,  is  frequently 
given  to  churches  in  general,  of  which 
there  are  innumerable  instances  in  ancient 
Christian  writers  (Euseb.  lib.  x.  c.  3,  &c. ; 
Soc.  H.  E.  i.  18 ;  Soz.  ii.  5).  But  generally 
the  name  oratory  seems  confined  to  private 
chapels,  or  places  of  worship  set  up  for  the 
convenience  of  monasteries  (St  Aug.  Epist. 
211,  sec.  7)  or  of  private  families.  In  the 
latter  case  they  depended  on  the  parochial 
churches,  and  differed  from  them  in  this, 
that  they  were  only  places  of  prayer,  but 
not  for  celebrating  the  communion;  or,  if 
that  were  at  any  time  allowed  to  private 
families,  yet,  at  least,  upon  great  and  solemn 
festivals,  the}'  were  to  resort  for  communion 
to  the  parish  churches. — Broughton,  Bihlio. 
ii.  s.  V.  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  1464. 

ORATORY,  PEIESTS  OF  THE.  There 
are  two  congregations  of  monks,  one  in  Italy, 
the  other  in  France,  which  are  called  by 
this  name. 

I.  The  priests  of  the  oratory  in  Italy  had 
for  their  founder  Philip  Neri,  a  native  of 
Florence,  who,  in  the  year  1548,  founded  at 
Rome  the  Confraternity  of  the  Holy  Trinity, 
which  originally  consisted  of  but  fifteen 
poor  persons,  who  assembled  in  the  church 
of  St.  Saviour  in  campo,  every  first  Sunday 
in  the  month,  to  practise  the  exercises  of 
piety  prescribed  by  the  holy  founder.  The 
pope  gave  leave  to  assemble  in  the  church 
of  St.  Girolamo  della  Carilk,  from  the  Ora- 
torio or  chapel  in  which  church  they  derived 
their  name.  Their  numbers  very  soon  in- 
creased, and  in  1574  the  Florentines  at 
Rome,  with  the  permission  of  Pope  Gregory 
2III.,  built  a  very  spacious  oratory,  in 
which  Neri  continued  his  religious  assemblies. 
The  pope  likewise  gave  him  the  parochial 


ORATORY,  PEIESTS  OP  THE        543 

church  of  Vallicella,  and,  the  same  year, 
approved  the  constitutions  he  had  drawn 
up  for  the  government  of  his  congregation, 
of  which  St  Philip  himself  was  the  first 
general. 

This  new  institute  soon  made  a  great 
progress,  and  divers  other  establishments 
were  made  on  the  same  model;  particu- 
larly at  Naples,  Milan,  Fermo,  and  Pa- 
lermo. The  founder  having  resigned  the 
office  of  general,  he  was  succeeded  therein 
by  Baronius,  who  was  afterwards  promoted 
to  the  dignity  of  a  cardinal.  Neri  died  the 
25th  of  May,  1595,  and  was  canonized  in 
1622  by  Pope  Gregory  XV.  After  his 
death,  this  congregation  made  a  further  pro- 
gress in  Italy,  and  has  produced  several 
cardinals  and  eminent  writers,  as  Baronius, 
Odoric  Eainaldi,  and  others. 

II.  The  priests  of  the  Oratory  in  France 
were  established  upon  the  model  of  those  in 
Italy,  and  owe  their  rise  to  Peter  de  Berulle, 
a  native  of  Champagne,  who  resolved  upon 
this  foundation,  in  order  to  restore  the  mon- 
astic system,  and  to  revive  the  splendour  of 
the  ecclesiastical  state,  which  was  greatly 
sunk  through  the  miseries  of  the  civU  wars, 
the  increase  of  heresies,  and  a  general  corrup- 
tion of  manners,  and  debasement  of  morals. 
To  this  end  he  assembled  a  community  of 
ecclesiastics,  in  1611,  in  the  suburb  of  St. 
James,  where  is  at  present  the  famous  mon- 
astery of  Val-de-Grace  ;  the  intention  being 
really  to  oppose  the  Jesuits.  They  obtained 
the  king's  letters  patent  for  their  estabhsh- 
ment ;  and,  in  1613,  Pope  Paul  V.  approved 
this  congregation  under  the  title  of  the 
Oratory  of  Jesus.  Berulle  was  a  friend  of 
Henrietta  Maria,  queen  of  Charles  I.  He 
solicited  the  dispensation  for  her  marriage  at 
Rome,  and  accompanied  her  to  England. 
The  English  schism,  as  he  called  it,  he  at- 
tributed to  the  unconoiliatory  spirit  with 
which  Henry  VIII.  was  met  at  Rome.  He 
had  made  a  vow  in  early  hfe  to  accept  no 
ecclesiastical  dignity,  but  Urban  VIII.  dis- 
pensed with  his  vow,  and  made  him  a 
cardinal.  Richeheu  was  jealous  of  his  in- 
fiuence,  and  as  he  died  suddenly  in  1629 
there  were  suspicions  that  his  death  was 
attributable  to  the  minister's  agency,  but  of 
this  there  was  not  the  smallest  evidence. 
After  his  death  the  priests  of  the  Oratory 
made  great  progress  in  Prance  and  other 
countries.  This  order  had  eleven  houses  in 
the  Low  Countries,  one  at  Liege,  two  in  the 
county  of  Avignon,  and  one  in  Savoy,  be- 
sides fifty-eight  in  France.  The  fii'st  house, 
which  was,  as  it  were,  the  mother  of  all  the 
rest,  was  that  of  the  Street  St.  Honore,  at 
Paris,  where  the  general  resided.  The  priests 
of  this  congregation  were  not,  properly  speak- 
ing, monks,  being  obhged  to  no  vows,  and 
their  institute  being  purely  ecclesiastical  or 


514 


ORDEAL 


sacerdotal.  They  are  called  Fathers  of  the 
Oratory,  because  they  have  no  churches 
ill  which  the  sacraments  are  administered, 
but  only  chapels  or  oratories,  in  which  they 
read  prayers,  and  preach.  The  Oratorians 
have  now  an  establishment  in  England. 

ORDEAL  (Sax.  ordal,  or  ordml;  Ger. 
urtheil;  D.  oordeel.  The  last  syllable  "  deal " 
is  to  distribute  or  distinguish,  and  the  prefix 
"or"  means  "without,"  thus  signifying  a 
dealing  out,  separation  or  discrimination, 
hence  "a  decision."  An  appeal  to  the 
judgment  of  Almighty  God,  in  criminal 
cases,  when  the  iDnocence  or  guilt  of  the 
accused  rested  on  iasufBcient  evidence. 

Among  the  Saxons,  if  any  person  was 
charged  with  theft,  adultery,  murder,  treason, 
perjury,  &c.,  in  these  cases,  if  the  person 
neither  pleaded  guilty,  nor  could  be  con- 
victed by  legal  evidence,  it  was  either  in 
the  prosecutor's  or  judge's  power  to  put 
him  upon  the  ordeal ;  and  provided  he 
passed  through  this  test  unhurt,  he  was 
discharged :  otherwise  he  was  put  into  the 
hands  of  justice,  to  be  punished  as  the  law 
directed,  in  case  he  had  been  cast  by 
the  ordinary  forms  of  prosecution.  For 
we  are  to  observe,  that  this  trial  by  ordeal 
was  not  designed  for  the  punishment  of 
those  in  whose  cases  the  ordinary  forms 
had  miscarried;  the  intention  of  it  was 
rather  to  clear  the  truth,  where  it  could 
not  be  other^vise  discovered,  and  make  way 
for  the  execution  of  the  law. 

Among  the  tests  were  (1)  throwing  the  ac- 
cused into  water ;  causing  him  (2)  to  thrust 
his  arm  into  boiling  water,  (3)  to  carry  a  red 
hot  iron,  (4)  to  walk  bhndfold  and  barefoot 
amongst  red  hot  ploughshares,  (5)  to  eat 
corsned,  or  consecrated  bread,  which  would 
choke  the  guilty.  To  these  the  Normans 
added  trial  by  wager  of  battle  (See  Battle). 
Dunstan  was  subjected  to  the  ordeal  of  cold 
water ;  Queen  Emma  to  that  of  fire.  But 
the  trial  by  ordeal  was  never  really  sanctioned 
by  the  Church  (Hook's  Archbishops,  i.  352) ; 
and  common  as  it  had  been  in  England,  and 
other  parts  of  Christendom,  being  indeed 
directly  encouraged  by  Charles  the  Great, 
it  fell  several  times  under  the  censure  of 
the  Church  and  State  :  thus  Louis,  and 
Lothair  his  successor,  emperors  of  Germany, 
positively  forbade  the  ordeal  by  cold  water. 
The  trial  hkewise  by  scalding  water,  and 
burning  iron,  was  condemned  by  Pope 
Stephen  V.  It  is  probable  they  might  think 
it  a  rash  way  of  proceeding,  and  a  tempting 
of  God;  and  that  it  was  unreasonable  to 
put  iimocence  upon  supernatural  proof,  and 
pronounce  a  man  guilty,  unless  he  had  a 
miracle  to  acquit  him.  The  first  public  dis- 
countenance of  it  from  the  State  which  we 
meet  with  in  England,  was  in  the  third  year 
of  King  Henry  HI.     Most  of  the  judges  in 


ORDERS 

their  circuits  received  an  order  from  the 
king  and  council  not  to  put  any  person 
upon  the  trial  by  ordeal.  And  though  we 
meet  with  no  express  law  afterwards  to  this 
purpose,  yet  this  method  of  trial,  standing 
condemned  by  the  canons,  languished  by 
degrees,  and  at  last  died  out  (Spelman's 
Gloss.  439  ;  Stephen's  Blachstone,  iv.  475  ; 
Lingard,  ii.  290;  Hallam,  Mid,  Ages,  iii. 
294). 

ORDER.  L  The  service  in  the  Prayer 
Book  for  morning  and  evening  is  styled  the 
"  Order  for  Morning  Prayer."  The  word  in 
the  sense  here  intended  means  simply  regu- 
lation, and  so  is  equivalent  to  "  prescribed 
form,"  being  derived  from  the  Latin  ordo. 
In  this  sense  it  is  also  used  with  regard  to 
the  administration  of  the  Holy  Communion 
— the  "  Order  of  Communion  "  having  been 
authorised  in  1547  by  Convocation  and 
Parliament,  and  issued  under  a  Proclama- 
tion of  the  Crown  on  March  8,  1547-8. 
The  "order"  began  with  the  exhortation 
which  was  reproduced  in  the  Prayer  Book 
of  1549,  and  is  identical  with  that  in  our 
present  Prayer  Book,  except  that  the  last 
paragraph  is  omitted.  The  word  "order" 
is  in  our  Prayer  Book  only  used,  beside  the 
above,  in  connexion  with  the  offices  for 
Confirmation,  Visitation  of  the  Sick,  and 
Burial  of  the  Dead;  but,  of  course,  every 
authorised  service  is  an  "  order."    [H.] 

II.  The  rules  or  laws  of  a  monastic  in- 
stitution; and  afterwards,  in  a  secondary 
sense,  the  several  monastics  living  under 
the  same  rule  or  order.  Thus  the  Order  of 
Cluny  signifies  literally  the  new  rule  of 
discipline  prescribed  by  Odo  to  the  Bene- 
dictines already  assembled  in  the  monastery 
of  Cluny;  but  secondarily,  and  in  the 
more  popular  sense,  the  great  body  of 
monastic  institutions,  wherever  established, 
which  voluntarily  subjected  themselves  to 
the  same  rule. 

ORDERS,  HOLY  (See  Bisliop,  Clergy, 
Deacon,  Ordinal,  Ordination,  Presbyter, 
Priest).  "  It  is  evident  unto  all  men  dili- 
gently reading  the  Holy  Scriptures  and  an- 
cient authors,  that  from  the  apostles'  time 
there  have  been  these  orders  of  ministers 
in  Christ's  Church;  bishops,  priests,  and 
deacons.  Which  offices  were  evermore  had 
in  such  reverent  estimation,  that  no  man 
might  presume  to  execute  any  of  them  ex- 
cept he  were  first  called,  tried,  examined, 
and  known  to  have  such  qualities  as  are 
requisite  for  the  same :  and  also  by  public 
prayer,  with  imposition  of  hands,  were  ap- 
proved and  admitted  thereunto  by  lawful 
authority.  And  therefore,  to  the  intent 
that  these  orders  might  be  continued 
and  reverently  used  and  esteemed,  in 
the  Church  of  England  no  man  shall 
be  accounted  or   taken  to    be   a  bishop, 


ORDERS 

priest,  or  deacon  of  the  Church  of  Eng- 
land or  suffered  to  execute  any  of  the 
said  functions,  except  he  be  called,  tried, 
examined,  and  admitted  there  unto,  accord- 
ing to  the  form  hereafter  following,  or 
hatli  had  formerly  episcopal  consecration 
or  ordination." — Preface  to  the  English 
Ordinal. 

As  it  is  here  said,  in  the  ancient  Church 
these  three  orders  of  ministry,  as  estab- 
lished by  Christ  and  His  apostles,  univer- 
sally prevailed.  But,  besides  the  bishops, 
priests,  and  deacons,  there  were,  in  most 
of  the  Churches,  other  ecclesiastical  per- 
sons of  inferior  rank,  Avho  were  allowed  to 
take  part  in  the  ministrations  of  religion. 
These  constituted  what  are  called  the  in- 
ferior orders,  and  in  some  of  the  ancient 
canons  they  have  the  name  of  "  clergy." 

There  is  this  great  difference  between 
the  three  holy  orders  and  the  others,  that 
the  former  are  everywhere  mentioned  as 
those  degrees  of  men  whose  ministrations 
were  known  and  distinguished,  and  with- 
out which  no  Church  was  looked  upon  as 
complete  ;  but  to  show  that  the  inferior 
orders  were  never  thought  to  be  necessary 
in  the  same  degree,  let  it  be  considered 
that  different  Churches,  or  the  same  Church 
in  different  ages,  had  more  or  fewer  of  the 
inferior  orders.  In  some  were  only  readers ; 
in  others  subdeacons,  exorcists,  and  acolyths. 
The  Apostolic  Canons  mention  only  sub- 
deacons,  readers,  and  singers.  The  Laodi- 
cean enumerates  these,  and  also  exorcists 
and  ostiaries.  But  while  there  was  no 
standing  rule  respecting  these  merely  ec- 
clesiastical orders,  the  three  essential  grades 
of  the  ministry  were  found  in  all  parts  of 
the  Church. 

In  the  Church  of  England,  the  following 
are  the  regulations  respecting  admission 
to  Holy  Orders  observed  in  the  various 
dioceses,  as  given  in  Hodgson's  "  Instruc- 
tions." 

Persons  desirous  of  being  admitted  as 
candidates  for  deacon's  orders,  are  recom- 
mended to  make  a  written  application  to 
the  bishop,*  six  months  before  the  time  of 
ordination,  stating  their  age,  college,  aca- 
demical degree,  and  the  usual  place  of  their 
residence ;  together  with  the  names  of  any 
persons  of  respectability  to  whom  they  are 
best  known,  and  to  whom  the  bishop  may 
apply,  if  he  thinks  fit,  for  further  informa- 
tion concerning  them. 

The  following  six  papers  are  to  be  sent 
by  a  candidate  for  deacon's  orders,  to  the 
bishop  in  whose  diocese  the  curacy  which 
is  to  serve  as  a  title  is  situate,  three  weeks 
before  the  day  of  ordination,  or  at  such  other 
time  as  the  bishop  shall  appoint;   and   in 

*  As  the  practice  may  not  be  alike  in  every  diocese, 
application  sliould  l)e  made  by  a  Candidate  to  the  ijishop's 
secretary  for  instructions. 


ORDERS 


515 


due  time  he  will  be  informed  by  the  bishop's 
secretary  when  and  where  to  attend  for 
examination. 

1.  Letters  testimonial  from  his  coUege; 
and  in  case  the  candidate  shall  have  quitted 
college,  he  must  also  present  letters  testi- 
monial for  the  period  elapsed  since  he  quitted 
college,  in  the  following  form,  signed  by 
three  beneficed  clergymen,  and  countersigned 
by  the  bishop  of  the  diocese  in  which  their 
benefices  are  respectively  situate,  if  they  are 
not  beneficed  in  the  diocese  of  the  bishop  to 
whom  the  candidate  applies  for  ordination. 

2.  Form  of  letters  testimonial  for  orders. 

"  To  the  *Eight  Reverend  ,  by  Di- 
vine permission  Lord  Bishop  of 

{the  bishop  in  whose  diocese  the  curacy 
conferring  the  title  is  situate]. 

Whereas  our  beloved   in  Christ,  A.  B., 

bachelor  of  arts  {or  other  degree),  of 

college,  in  the  university  of ,  hath  de- 
clared to  us  his  intention  of  ofiering  him- 
self as  a  candidate  for  the  sacred  office  of  a 
deacon,  and  for  that  end  hath  requested 
of  us  letters  testimonial  of  his  good  life  and 
conversation ;  we  therefore,  whose  names 
are  hereunto  subscribed,  do  testify  that  the 
said  A.  B.  hath  been  personally  known  to 

us  for  the  space  off last  past ;  that  we 

have  had  opportunities  of  observing  his 
conduct ;  that  during  the  whole  of  that  time 
we  verily  believe  that  he  lived  piously, 
soberly,  and  honestly ;  nor  have  we  at  any 
time  heard  anything  to  the  contrary  there- 
of; nor  hath  he  at  any  time,  as  far  as  we 
know  or  believe,  held,  written,  or  taught 
anything  contrary  to  the  doctrine  or  discip- 
line of  the  Church  of  England ;  and,  more- 
over, we  believe  him,  in  our  consciences  to 
be,  as  to  his  moral  conduct,  a  person 
worthy  to  be  admitted  to  the  sacred  order 
of  deacons. 

In  witness   whereof  we  have  hereunto 

subscribed  our  names  this day  of 

,  in  the  year  of  our  Lord  18 — . 

JC.  D.  rector  of . 

E.  F.  vicar  of . 

G.  H.  rector  of ." 

[  Oounter-signature.1 

3.  Form  of  notice  or  "  Si  quis,"  and  of 

the  certificate'of  the  same  having  been 
published  in  the  church  of  the  parish 
where  the  candidate  usually  resides,  to 
be  presented  by  the  candidate  if  he 
shall  have  quitted  college. 
"Notice  is  hereby  given,   that  A.    B., 

*  It  Is  to  be  observed  tliat  the  proper  address  to  an 

archbishop  is,  *'To  the  Most  Reverend ,by  Divine 

Providence  Lord  Archbishop  of ; "  and  the  style 

"Grace"  is  to  be  used  instead  of  "Lordship."  The 
proper  address  to  any  other  Bishop  Is,  "  To  the  Eight 
Eeverend ,  by  Divine  Providence ." 

t  For  three  years,  or  such  shorter  period  as  may 
have  elapsed  since  the  date  of  the  College  testimonial. 

%  It  is  recommended  that  the  party  giving  the  title  bo 
not  one  of  the  subscrilMir?. 

2   N 


546 


ORDERS 


bachelor  of  arts  {or  other  degree),  of 

college,  Oxford  [or  Cambridge],  and  now 
resident  in  this  parish,  intends  to  offer 
himself  a  candidate  for  the  holy  office  of 
a  deacon,  at  the  ensuing  ordination  of  the 

Lord  Bishop  of ;  *  and  if  any  person 

knows  any  just  cause  or  impediment  for 
which  he  ought  not  to  be  admitted  into 
holy  orders,  he  is  now  to  declare  the  same, 
or  to  signify  the  same  forthwith  to  the 
Lord  Bishop  of . 

We  do  hereby  certify,  that  the  above 
notice  was  publicly  read  by  the  under- 
signed C.  D.,  in  the  parish  church  of , 

in  the  county  of ,  during  the  time  of 

Divine  service  on  Sunday  the  day  of 

last  [or  instant],  and  no  impediment 

was  alleged. 

Witness  our    hands    this  day    of 

,  in  the  year  of  our  Lord  18 — . 

C.  D.  officiating  minister. 
E.  P.  churchwarden." 

4.  Certificate  from  the  divinity  professor 
in  the  university,  that  the  candidate  has 
duly  attended  his  lectures.  Also  a  certificate 
from  any  other  professor  whose  lectures  the 
candidate  may  have  been  directed  by  the 
bishop  to  attend. 

5.  Certificate  of  the  candidate's  baptism, 
from  the  register  book  of  the  parish  where 
he  was  baptized,  duly  signed  by  the  ofiici- 
ating  minister,  to  show  that  he  has  com- 
pleted his  age  of  twenty-three  years ;  and 
in  case  he  shall  have  attained  that  age,  but 
cannot  produce  a  certificate  of  his  baptism, 
then  his  father  or  mother,  or  other  compe- 
tent person,  must  make  a  declaration  before 
a  justice  of  the  peace,  of  the  actual  time  of 
his  birth :  and  here  it  may  be  necessary  to 
remark,  that  byan  Act  of  the  44  Geo.  III.  c. 
43,  intituled  "  An  Act  to  enforce  the  due 
observance  of  the  canons  and  rubric  re- 
specting the  ages  of  persons  to  be  admitted 
into  the  sacred  order  of  deacon  and  priest," 
it  is  enacted,  that  thenceforth  no  person 
shall  be  admitted  a  deacon  before  he  shall 
have  attained  the  age  of  three  and  twenty 
years  complete;  and  that  no  person  shall 
be  admitted  a  priest  before  he  shall  have 
attained  the  age  of  four  and  twenty  years 
complete:  and  that  if  a  person  shall  be 
admitted  a  deacon  before  he  shall  have 
attained  the  age  of  twenty-three  years 
complete,  or  a  priest  before  he  shall  have 
attained  the  age  of  twenty-four  years  com- 
plete, such  admission  shall  be  void  in  law  ; 
and  the  person  so  admitted  shall  be  in- 
capable of  holding  any  ecclesiastical  prefer- 
ment. 

6.  ITie  form  of  a  nomination  to  serve  as 

a  title  for  orders,  if  the  incumbent  is 
non-resident. 
*  The  bishop  in  whose  diocese  the  curacy  conferring 
the  titie  is  situate. 


ORDERS 

To  the   Eight  Reverend  ,  Lord 

Bishop  of . 

These  are  to  certify  your  lordship  that 

I,  C.  D.,  rector  [or  vicar,  &c.]  of ,  in 

the  county   of  ,   and  your  lordship's 

diocese  of ,  do  hereby  nominate  A.  B., 

bachelor  of  arts  (or  other  degree),  of 

college,  in  the  university  of  ,  to 

perform  the  office  of  curate  in  my  church 

of aforesaid ;  and  do  promise  to  allow 

him  the  yearly  stipend  of pounds,  to 

be  paid  by  equal  quarterly  payments  [as 
to  amount  of  stipend,  see  title  "  Stipends 
payable  to    Curates "],   with   the   surplice 

fees,   amounting  on  an    average    to  

pounds  per  annum  (if  they  are  intended  to 
be  allowed),  and  the  use  of  the  glebe-house, 
garden,  and  offices,  which  he  is  to  occupy 
(if  that  be  the  fact ;  if  not,  state  the  reason, 
and  name  ivhere  and  i(<hat  distance*  from 
the  church  the  curate  purposes  to  reside)  : 
and  I  do  hereby  state  to  your  lordship,  that 
the  said  A.  B.  does  not  intend  to  serve  as 
curate  in  any  other  parish,  nor  to  officiate 
in  any  other  church  or  chapel  (if  such  be  the 
fact,  otherwise  state  the  real  fact) ;  that 
the  net  annual  value  of  my  said  benefice, 
estimated  according  to  the  Act  of  Parlia- 
ment 1  &  2  Victoria,  c.  106,  sects.  8  and 

10,  is  pounds,   and  the    population 

thereof,  according  to  the  latest  returns  of 
population  made    under   the  authority  of 

parliament,  is  .     That  there  is  only 

one  church  belonging  to  my  said  benefice 
(if  there  be  another  church  or  chapel,  state 
the  fact) ;  and  that  I  was  admitted  to  the 

said  benefice  on  the day  of 18 — .f 

"And  I  do  hereby  promise  and  engage 
with  your  lordship  and  the  said  A.  B.  that 
I  will  continue  to  employ  the  said  A.  B., 
in  the  office  of  curate  in  my  said  church, 
until  he  shall  be  otherwise  provided  of 
some  ecclesiastical  preferment,  unless,  for 
any  fault  by  him  committed,  he  shall  be 
lawfully  removed  from  the  same ;  and  I 
hereby  solemnly  declare  that  I  do  not 
fraudulently  give  this  certificate  to  entitle 
the  said  A.  B.  to  receive  holy  orders,  but 
with  a  real  intention  to  employ  him  in  my 
said  church,  according  to  what  is  before 
expressed." 

Witness  my  hand  this day  of , 

in  the  year  of  our  Lord  18 — . 

[Signature  and  address  ofl     C.  D." 

Declaration  [to  be  written  at  the  foot  of  the 
Nomination^. 
"  We  the  before-named  C.  D.  and  A.  B. 

do  declare  to  the  said  Lord  Bishop  of , 

as  follows ;  namely,  I,  the  said  C.  D.,  do- 

*  See  76th  sect,  of  1  &  2  Victoria,  c.  106. 

f  The  concluding  part  of  the  nomination,  within  in- 
verted commas,  is  not  to  be  used,  except  in  the  nomina- 
tion to  serve  as  a  title  for  orders. 


OEDEES 

declare  that  I  hond  fide  intend  to  pay,  and 
I,  the  said  A.  B.,  do  declare  that  I  bond  fide 
intend  to  receive,  the  whole  actual  stipend 
mentioned  iu  the  foregoing  nomination  and 
statement,  without  any  abatement  in  respect 
of  rent  or  consideration  for  the  use  of  the 
glebe-house,  garden,  and  offices  thereby 
agreed  to  be  assigned,  and  without  any 
other  deduction  or  reservation  whatsoever. 

Witness  our  hands  this day  of , 

18—. 

^Signatures  of]        C.  D. 
A.  B." 
6.  (a)  The  form  of  nomination  to  serve 
as  a  title  for  orders,  if  the  incumbent 
is  resident. 

The  same  form  as  No.  6,  so  far  as 
"  quarterly  payments ; ''  then  proceed  as 
follows : — And  I  do  hereby  state  to  your 
lordship,  that  the  said  A.  B.  intends  to  re- 
side in  the  said  parish,  in  a  house  [describe 
its  situation,  so  as  dearly  to  identify  W], 

distant  from  my  chm-ch mile  \if  A.  B. 

does  not  intend  to  reside  in  the  parish,  then 
state  at  what  place  he  intends  to  reside,  and 
its  distance  from  the  said  church] ;  that  the 
said  A.  B.  does  not  intend  to  serve,  as  curate, 
any  other  parish,  nor  to  officiate  in  any 
other  church  or  chapel  (if  such  be  the  fact, 
othenvise  state  the  real  fact) ;  and  I  do 
hereby  promise  -and  engage  with  your  lord- 
ship, and  so  on  [in  the  same  for  in  as  No.  6, 
to  the  end]. 

Witness  my  hand  this day  of , 

18—. 

[Signature  and  address  of]     C.  D." 

The  declaration  to  be  written  at  the  foot 
of  the  nomination  is  to  be  in  the  same 
form  as  No.  6,  so  far  as  the  word  "  state- 
ment," after  which  proceed  as  follows : — 
"  Without  any  deduction  or  reservation 
whatsoever. 

Witness  our  hands  this day  of , 

18—. 

[Signatures  of] 


OEDEES 


547 


CD. 
A.  B." 


Instructions  as  to  Priest's  orders." 

The  following  papers  are  to  be  sent  by  a 
candidate  for  priest's  orders  to  the  bishop, 
three  weeks  before  the  day  of  ordination, 
or  at  such  other  time  as  the  bishop  shall 
appoint,  and  in  due  time  he  will  be  in- 
formed by  the  bishop's  secretary  when  and 
where  to  attend  for  examination. 

Where  a  candidate  applies  for  priest's 
orders  to  the  same  bishop  who  ordained 
him  deacon,  the  papers  1  and  2  only  are 
required. 

1.  Letters  testimonial  of  his  sound  doc- 
trine, good    life,   and    behaviour,   for    the 

*  It  is  not  usual  to  confer  priest's  orders  till  the 
candidate  has  been  a  deacon  one  whole  year. 


time  elapsed  since  he  was  ordained  deacon, 
signed  by  three  beneficed  clergymen,  and 
countersigned  by  the  bishop  of  the  diocese 
in  which  their  benefices  are  respectively 
situate,  if  not  beneficed  in  the  diocese  of 
the  bishop  to  whom  the  candidate  applies 
for  ordination  (See  Form  of  Testimonial 
in  Instructions  as  to  Deacon's  Orders, 
No.  2). 

2.  Notice  or  "  Si  quis,"  and  certificate 
of  the  publication  thereof  (See  Form 
thereof,  in  the  Instructions  as  to  Deacon's 
Orders,  No.  3). 

In  case  the  candidate  was  ordained  deacon 
by  the  bishop  of  another  diocese,  he  must 
produce  not  only  the  papers,  Nos.  1  and  2, 
l3ut  also  the  following  papers,  Nos.  -3,  4, 
and  5. 

As  it  is  not  common  for  a  deacon  to  be 
ordained  priest  by  any  other  than  the  bishop 
who  admitted  him  to  deacon's  orders,  a 
candidate  applying  to  the  bishop  of  another 
diocese  must,  in  the  first  instance,  state  to 
him  the  particular  circumstances  which 
occasion  the  application,  the  curacy  which 
he  served,  and  for  what  period. 

3.  Letters  of  deacon's  orders. 

4.  A  certificate  of  baptism. 

5.  Nomination,  if  not  already  licensed. 
The  same   subscriptions  and  oaths    are 

made  and  taken  by  candidates  for  priest's 
orders,  as  by  candidates  for  deacon's  orders. 

With  respect  to  foreign  Protestants,  Pal- 
mer observes  :  "  We  are  not  bound  to  con- 
demn Presbyterian  orders  in  every  case :  for 
instance,  the  appointment  of  ministers  by 
the  Protestants  in  Germany  during  the 
Reformation  was  most  probably  invalid ; 
and  yet,  considering  their  difficulties,  the 
fact  of  their  appeal  to  a  general  coxmcil, 
their  expectation  of  reunion  with  the  Church, 
and  therefore  the  impossibility  of  estab- 
lishing a  rival  hierarchy,  I  think  we  are  not 
bound  to  condemn  their  appointments  of 
ministers,  as  many  learned  and  orthodox 
writers  have  done,  who,  however,  seem  not 
to  have  observed  the  peculiarities  of  their 
position,  and  to  have  supposed  that  they 
were  at  once  definitively  separated  from  the 
Roman  churches.  Certain  differences  of 
opinion  then,  in  reference  to  the  question  of 
Presbyterian  ordinations,  may  exist  without 
any  material  inconvenience. 

"  That  ordinations  by  mere  presbyters 
are  (however  excusable  xmder  circumstances 
of  great  difficulty),  in  fact,  unauthorized 
and  invalid,  is  the  more  usual  sentiment  of 
theologians,  and  is  most  accordant  with 
Scripture,  and  with  the  practice  of  the 
Catholic  Church  in  general,  and  of  our 
Churches  in  particular,  which  do  not  recog- 
nise any  such  ordinations." — Hist,  of  tlie 
Church,  ii.  412.  See  Hooker,  iii.  p.  286. 
Ed.  Keble. 

2  N  2 


54S 


OEDEES 


The  only  legal  questions  upon  this  subject 
are  as  to  the  authority  which  any  particular 
ordination  gives  to  the  ordinee  to  perform 
any  clerical  duty  in  the  Church  of  England 
when  duly  licensed  by  a  bishop,  and  that  has 
been  more  or  less  settled  by  sundry  Acts  of 
Parliament,  which  alone  can  determine  it, 
through  the  courts,  when  it  is  doubtful  or 
disputed.  These  have  been  mostly  dealt 
with  already  under  Colonial  Church  and 
Church  in  Scotland.  It  Is  singular  that  it 
has  never  been  judicially  decided,  though  it 
was  said  by  Lord  Lyndhurst  in  R.  v.  Millis 
(see  Marriage)  to  be  generally  accepted, 
that  the  ambiguous  phrase  in  the  Act  of 
Uniformity  of  1662,  "unless  he  hath  for- 
merly had  episcopal  ordination,"  recognises 
ordinees  of  the  Roman  Church,  though  no 
Roman  bishop  has  any  authority  from  the 
State  to  ordain  here ;  and  Sir  Matthew 
Hale  says  in  his  tract  on  the  Royal  Supre- 
macy :  "  The  determination  of  the  exercise 
of  the  power  of  ordination  as  to  time,  place, 
jjerson,  and  manner  of  performance  is  de- 
rived from  the  Crown,  though  the  power  of 
ordination  is  not,  but  from  Christ."  The 
ambiguity  in  the  Act  of  Uniformity  is 
whether  the  words  "  hath  had  "  were  meant 
to  apply  to  all  future  ordinees  or  only  to 
those  of  that  time,  and  there  is  room  for  a 
good  deal  of  argument  both  ways.  Probably 
the  decision  would  be  in  conformity  with 
Lord  Lyndhurst's  statement,  though  it  did 
not  profess  to  be  even  a  legal  dictum  of  his 
own,  and  much  less  a  legal  decision,  for  it 
was  not  at  all  necessary  for  the  decision  of 
that  case.  But  even  then,  the  Colonial 
Clergy  Act,  1874,  includes  a  fortiori,  Roman 
ordinees,  and  prevents  them  from  performing 
any  services  in  our  church  without  the 
written  permission  of  the  archbishop  of  the 
province,  and  from  holding  any  living  or 
curacy  without  permission  also  of  the  bishop, 
independently  of  his  general  right  to  ex- 
amine them  as  to  orthodoxy  even  if  pre- 
sented by  another  patron.  That  applies  to 
every  person  ordained  by  any  but  the  bishop 
of  an  English  diocese  or  his  deputy.  And 
therefore  it  is  unnecessary  to  pursue  the 
inquiry  as  to  what  other  professedly  "epi- 
scopal ordinations "  would  be  recognised 
tmder  the  Act  of  Uniformity.  There  is  no 
doubt  that  unauthorised  ordinations  by 
persons  who  have  themselves  been  pro- 
fessedly consecrated  as  bishops  without  any 
lawful  authority  by  those  who  may  have 
been  lawful  bishops,  though  not  acting 
lawfully  therein,  would  be  treated  as  not 
"  having  had  episcopal  ordination,"  and  the 
performers  of  any  such  ceremony  in  England, 
if  clergymen,  are  guilty  of  an  ecclesiastical 
offence.  Nor  would  the  so-called  ordinations 
of  any  sect  which  chooses  to  call  some  of  its 
officers  "  bishops  "  be  recognised  as  "  epi- 


ORDINAL 

scopal  ordination  "  under  the  Acts  of  Parlia- 
ment which  require  It.     [G.] 

ORDERS,  MINOR.  Tliere  were  five 
classes  of  persons  who  had  a  certain  office  in 
the  Church  in  early  times,  but  were  not  or- 
dained to  the  higher  ministry.  These  were 
(I)  sub-deacons,  (2)  acolyths,  (3)  exorcists, 
(4)  readers,  and  (5)  porters,  or  door-keepers. 
Cornelius,  bishop  of  Rome  about  a.d.  250, 
said,  according  to  Eusebius,  that  there  were 
at  Rome  in  his  time  forty-six  priests,  seven 
deacons,  as  many  sub-deacons,  forty-two 
acolyths,  and  fifty-two  porters,  exorcists  and 
readers  (Ap.  Euseb.  JI.  E.  lib.  vi.  c.  xliii.  • 
ed.  Migne,  tom.  ii.  p.  621).  Roman  ritualists, 
such  as  BeUarmine,  assert  that  these  minor 
orders  were  of  apostolical  origin,  and  they 
were  as  such  upheld  in  the  Council  of  Trent 
{Cone.  Trid.  sess.  23,  c.  2  ;  Bellarm.  de 
Clericis,  lib.  1,  c.  11).  But  Bona  and  others 
make  a  distinction  between  the  sub-deacons 
and  the  other  four  classes,  stating  that  the 
latter  cannot  be  called  of  apostolic  institu- 
tion, but  that  with  regard  to  the  former — 
the  sub-deacons — this  institution  must  be 
refen-ed  to  Christ,  or  at  least  to  His  apostles 
(Bona,  Rer.  Liturg.  lib.  1.  c.  25,  n.  17).  The 
duties  of  those  in  inferior  or  minor  orders,  as 
they  were  called,  are  laid  down  in  the  fourth 
Council  of  Carthage,  a.d.  398.  It  would 
seem  that  the  churchwardens,  sidesmen, 
vergers,  bell-ringers,  and  parish  clerks  of  our 
times  hold  very  much  the  same  position  as 
those  officers  in  "  Minor  Orders "  of  old. 
And  the  lay-readers,  with  commission  from 
the  bishop,  resemble  the  sub-deacons  (See 
Acolyths,  Exorcists,  Lay- Readers').    [H.]  . 

ORDERS  OF  MONKS.  The  several 
orders  of  monks  are  distinguished  in  this 
manner  by  their  habits.  The  White  Friars 
are  canons  regular  of  the  order  of  St. 
Augustine.  Grey  Friars  are  Cistercian 
monks,  who  changed  their  black  habit  into 
a  grey  one.  The  Black  Friars  are  Bene- 
dictines. 

ORDINAL.  L  The  existence  from  the 
earliest  ages  of  the  Church  of  a  constituted 
order,  or  orders  of  the  ministry,  is  an  historic 
fact  (See  Apostolic  Succession).  And  it  is 
no  less  certain  that  while  the  choice  of 
ministers  belonged  to  the  whole  body  of  the 
Church,  the  solemn  ordination  of  such  as 
have  been  chosen,  has  always  belonged  to 
the  apostles,  and  their  successors  in  the 
ministry,  by  an  authority  tracing  itself  up 
to  Christ  Himself,  and  not  derived  directly 
from  the  congregation.  That  there  was  or- 
dination in  the  times  of  the  apostles  is  clear 
from  Scriptural  authority  (Acts  vi.  6 : 
xiv.  23 :  xiii.  3 ;  1  Tim.  v.  22,  &c.).  And 
from  the  earliest  times,  forms  of  service  for 
this  solemn  ordination  and  mission  were 
observed  in  the  Church.  It  is  impossible  to 
doubt  that  St.  Ignatius  (_ad  Magnes.  c.  vi.  & 


ORDINAL 

vii.),  St.  IreniBus  {Hair.  1,  iii.  c.  iii.),  Clement 
of  Alexandiia  (Strom.  1,  vi.  c.  xiii.),  Ter- 
tullian  (de  Bapt.  c.  xvii.),  and  many  others, 
referred  to  such  ordination  services.  The 
earliest  form,  no  doubt,  was  perfectly  simple. 
There  was  the  imposition  of  hands  with 
prayer  and  benediction,  and  solemn  mission 
in  the  name  of  Jesus  Christ  (Palmer,  Orig. 
Liturg.  ii.  p.  304).  This  gradually  developed 
into  greater  fulness  and  elaborateness  in 
ceremonial,  both  in  the  East  and  West,  but 
the  essential  parts  remained  the  same.  There 
are  some  very  early  forms  of  this  office  ex- 
tant (see  MabilloD,  Mus.  Ital.  vol.  ii.  85), 
but  the  Greek,  the  Coptic,  the  Jacobite,  the 
Maronite,  and  the  Nestorian  ordinals  agree 
in  substance,  only  with  independent  varie- 
ties. ,  In  the  West  the  ofiice  for  ordination 
is  to  be  found,  with  slight  variations,  in 
the  Sacramentaries  of  Leo  I.,  Gelasius  and 
Gregory. 

II.  From  these  old  sources  the  Ordinal  of 
the  Church  of  England  was  compiled.  The 
"  Pontifical "  of  Egbert,  which  has  been 
published  by  the  Surtees  Society,  had  great 
influence ;  but  the  most  common  "  use " 
afterwards  was  that  of  Salisbury  which 
has  been  printed  by  Maskell  in  his 
Monumenta  Ritualta.  This  seems  to  have 
been  the  groundwork  of  our  Ordinal,  with 
many  alterations,  especially  in  the  hortatory 
portions,  and  ritual  observances.  In  1548-9 
a  committee  consisting  of  the  Primate  of 
England  (Cranmer)  and  other  prelates,  to- 
gether with  "  other  men  of  this  realm,  learned 
in  God's  law,"  was  appointed  to  revise  the 
Ordinal,  and,  according  to  Burnet,  a  great 
many  of  the  bishops  took  part  in  this  re- 
vision. By  an  Act  of  Parliament,  Jan.  31, 
1550,  the  king  was  empowered  to  appoint 
six  prelates,  and  six  other  learned  men  to 
prepare  the  book,  which  was  brought  to  the 
Council  on  Feb.  28  in  the  same  year,  signed 
by  eleven  of  the  commissioners.  Heath, 
tishop  of  Worcester,  only  refusing  to  sub- 
scribe. The  form  of  the  oath  of  supremacy 
was  objected  to  by  some,  for  it  ran — "  so 
help  me  God,  all  Saints,  and  the  Holy 
Evangelists."  On  Hooper's  suggestion,  all 
mention  of  swearing  by  the  saints  was  struck 
out  by  the  king's  own  hand,  on  July  20, 
and  Hooper,  when  he  afterwards  accepted 
the  bishopric  of  Gloucester,  took  the  oath  as 
amended  {Orig.  Lett,  cclxiii. :  an  account 
of  this  is  given  by  Hooper  in  a  letter  to 
BuUinger,  Orig.  Lett,  xxxix.).  The  book  was 
called  the  "Form  and  Manner  of  making 
and  consecrating  of  Archbishops,  Bishops, 
Priests,  and  Deacons."  The  Act  added  "  and 
other  Ministers  of  the  Church ; "  but  the  com- 
missioners omitted  all  mention  of  minororders 
(see  Orders,  Minor).  This  form  is  reprinted 
in  "  Liturgies  and  Documents  of  the  reign  of 
Edw.  VI."  (Parker  Soo. :  see  Soames'  Hist. 


ORLINAL 


549 


Eeform.  Edw.  VI.  p.  521).  By  2  &  3  Ed- 
ward VI.  c.  11,  it  was  enacted  that  all  books 
heretofore  used  for  the  service  of  the  Church, 
other  than  such  as  shall  be  set  forth  by  the 
king's  majesty,  shall  bo  clearly  abolished 
(s.  1).  And  by  5  &  6  Edward  VI.  c.  1,  it 
is  thus  enacted :  'i'he  king,  with  the  assent 
of  the  lords  and  commons  in  parliament,  has 
annexed  tlieBook  of  Common  Prayer  to  this 
present  statute,  adding  also  a  form  and 
manner  of  making  and  consecrating  of  arch- 
bishops, bishops,  priests,  and  deacons,  to  be  of 
like  force  and  authority  as  the  Book  of  Com- 
mon Prayer.  And,  by  Art.  36 :  "  The  book 
of  consecration  of  archbishops  and  bishops, 
and  ordering  of  priests  and  deacons,  lately 
set  forth  in  the  time  of  Edward  VI.,  and 
confirmed  at  the  same  time  by  authority  of 
parliament,  doth  contain  all  things  necessary 
to  such  consecration  and  ordering ;  neither 
hath  it  anythingthatof  itself  is  superstitious 
and  ungodly.  And  therefore  whosoever  are 
consecrated  or  ordered  according  to  the  rites 
of  that  book,  since  the  second  year  of  the 
forenamed  King  Edward  unto  this  time,  or 
hereafter  shall  be  consecrated  or  ordered 
according  to  the  same  rites,  we  declare  all 
such  to  be  rightly  ordered,  and  lawfully  con- 
secrated and  ordered."  The  8th  Canon 
follows  the  direction  :  "Whosoever  shall 
affirm  or  teach,  that  the  fonn  and  manner 
of  making  and  consecrating  bishops,  priests, 
and  deacons,  containeth  anything  that,  is  re- 
pugnant to  the  word  of  God ;  or  that  they  who 
are  made  bishops,  priests,  and  deacons,  in  that 
form,  are  not  lawfully  made,  nor  ought  to 
be  accounted  either  by  themselves  or  others 
to  be  truly  either  bishops,  priests,  or  deacons, 
until  they  have  some  other  calling  to  those 
Divine  offices,  let  him  be  excommunicated, 
ipso  facto,  not  to  be  restored  until  he  repent 
and  publicly  revoke  such  his  wicked  errors." 

The  Ordinal  has  passed  through  three 
phases,  at  and  since  the  Eeformation,  which 
may  be  thus  concisely  stated.  (1)  In  1549 
Cranmer  and  other  bishops  were  appointed 
to  revise  the  old  form.  (2)  In  1552  a 
further  revision  took  place,  when  the  de- 
livery of  the  paten  and  chalice  to  the 
priests,  and  of  the  pastoral  staff  to  the 
bishops,  was  omitted  ;  and  also  the  direction 
that  the  candidates  lor  priests'  or  deacons' 
orders,  should  appear  in  ecclesiastical 
habits.  No  other  considerable  change  wa.s 
made.  (3)  In  1662  the  Ordinal  was  care- 
fully revised,  and  some  changes  of  no  great 
importance,  but  generally  tending  to  greater 
solemnity,  were  introduced.     [H.] 

III.  The  form  in  which  orders  are  con- 
ferred in  our  Church  is  this  :  "  The  bishop, 
with  the  priests  present,  shall  lay  their  hands 
severally  upon  the  head  of  every  one  that 
receiveth  the  order  of  priesthood ;  the  re- 
ceivers  humbly  kneeling,   and   the   bishop 


550 


OEDINAL 


saying,  'Receive  the  Holy  Ghost  for  the 
office  and  work  of  a  priest,  in  the  Church 
of  God,  now  committed  unto  thee  hy  the 
imposition  of  our  hands.  Whose  sins  thou 
dost  forgive,  they  are  forgiven ;  and  whose 
sins  thou  dost  retain,  they  are  retained. 
And  be  thou  a  faithful  dispenser  of  the  word 
of  God,  and  of  his  holy  sacraments :  in  the 
name  of  the  Father,  and  of  the  Son,  and  of 
the  Holy  Ghost.' "  In  the  office  for  the  order- 
ing of  deacons,  the  bishop  alone  lays  on  his 
hands,  but  does  not  use  the  words, "  Receive 
the  Holy  Ghost,"  &c.,  or  grant  authority  to 
forgive  or  retain  sins.  In  the  office  for  the 
consecration  of  bishops,  the  form  is  thus : 
"  Then  the  archbishop  and  bishops  present 
shall  lay  their  hands  upon  the  head  of  the 
elected  bishop,  kneeling  before  them  on  his 
knees,  the  archbishop  saying, '  Receive  the 
Holy  Ghost  for  the  office  and  work  of  a 
bishop  in  the  Church  of  God,  now  com- 
mitted unto  thee  by  the  laying  on  of  our 
hands,  in  the  name  of  the  Father,  and  of 
the  Son,  and  of  the  Holy  Ghost.  Amen. 
And  remember  that  thou  stir  up  the  grace  of 
God  which  is  given  thee  by  the  imposition  of 
our  hands,  for  God  hath  not  given  us  the 
spirit  of  fear,  but  of  power,  and  love,  and 
soberness.' " 

Several  Protestant  dissenting  communi- 
ties have  taken  it  upon  themselves  to  lay 
on  hands  when  a  person  is  elected  to  the 
dissenting  ministry ;  but  none,  that  we  are 
aware  of,  have  ever  assumed  the  solemn 
office  of  thus  conferring  the  grace  of  God 
by  the  imposition  of  human  hands,  which 
would  clearly  be  blasphemous,  except  there 
existed  a  commission  from  God  to  do  so, 
which  commission,  without  the  apostolical 
succession,  cannot  be  proved,  unless  by 
miracle.  This  form  has  given  great  offence 
to  many  conscientious  ultra-Protestants. 
Attempts  are  sometimes  made  to  explain 
the  words  away;  but  such  explanations 
have  been  seldom  found  satisfactory,  except 
to  those  whose  interest  it  is  to  be  satisfied. 
It  is  evident  that  they  are  to  be  understood 
simply,  clearly,  unequivocally,  to  express 
that  the  grace  of  God  is  given  by  the  im- 
position of  the  bishop's  hands ;  and  that  if 
we  speak  of  this  as  superstitious  or  ungodly, 
we  are,  as  may  be  seen  from  the  36th  Article 
and  the  8th  Canon,  under  the  anathema  of 
our  Church.  On  the  other  hand,  the  com- 
fort is  indescribably  great  to  those  who  be- 
lieve that  grace  ministerial  is  thus  conveyed 
in  attending  the  ministry  of  the  Church ; 
the  efficacy  of  the  ministrations  of  whoso 
ministers  depends  not  on  the  merit  or  talent 
of  the  individual,  but  on  the  grace  of  God, 
of  which  he  is  the  authorised,  though  un- 
worthy, dispenser. — Cardwell,  Boc.  Ann. 
XX.,  &c. ;  Burnet,  Hist.  Jtef.  pt.  ii.  b.  i.  ; 
Soames,  Hist.  Ref.  p.  521 ;  Collier,  Ecc.  Hist. 


ORDINATION 

pt.  ii.  b.  iv. ;  Heylin,  Hist.  Sef.  4  Ed.  VI. 
sec.  11  ;  Strype's  Mem.  of  Cranmer,  c.  xi.  ; 
Bishop  Barry's  P.  B.  p.  263,  a;  Hook's 
Archhishops,  Cranmer. 

ORDINANCES  OP  THE  CHURCH. 
Rites  ordained  by  God  to  be  means  of  grace, 
such  as,  1.  Baptism  (St.  Matt,  xxviii.  19)  ; 
2.  The  Lord's  supper  (St.  Matt.  xxvi.  26  ;  1 
Cor.  xi.  24,  &c.) ;  3.  Preaching  and  readint; 
the  word  (St.  Mark  xvi.  15 ;  Horn.  x.  15) ;  4. 
Hearing  the  gospel  (St.  Mark  iv.  24 ;  Rom. 
X.  17) ;  5.  Public  and  Private  prayer  (1  Coi-. 
xiv.  15,  19 ;  St.  Matt.  vi.  6 ;  Ps.  v.  1,  7) ;  6. 
Sinning  of  psalms  (Col.  iii.  16 ;  Eph.  v.  19)  ; 

7.  Fasting  (St.  Matt.  ix.  15 ;  Joel  ii.  12) ; 

8.  Solemn  thanksgiving  (Ps.  ix.  14;  1 
Thess.  V.  18)  (See  Rites). 

ORDINARY.  The  person  who  has 
ecclesiastical  jurisdiction,  as  of  course  and 
of  common  right,  in  opposition  to  persons 
who  are  extraordinarily  appointed.  In 
some  Acts  of  Parliament  we  find  the  bishop 
called  ordinary,  and  so  he  is  taken  at  the 
common  law,  as  having  ordinary  jurisdic- 
tion in  causes  ecclesiastical ;  at  the  same 
time,  in  a  more  general  acceptation,  the 
word  Ordinary  signifies  any  judge  autho- 
rised to  take  cognizance  of  causes  in  his 
own  proper  right.  Thus  Lyndwood  states 
that  ordinaries  are  those  "  quibus  competit 
jurisdictio  ordinaria  de  jure  privilegii,  vel 
consuetudine  "  (^Prov.  I.  tit.  ii.). 

ORDINATION.  I.  The  a|  ostles  ap- 
pointed bishops,  priests,  and  deacons  to  be 
the  standing  guides  and  governors  of  the 
Church  ;  and  because  there  should  be  a  suc- 
cession of  them  continued  in  all  ages,  for 
the  peace  and  preservation  of  those  churches 
which  they  had  planted,  therefore  it  is  ne- 
cessary that  there  should  be  a  power  lodged 
somewhere,  to  set  apart  some  distinct  orders 
of  men  to  those  public  offices,  and  this  is 
called  ordination.  Many  dissenting  sects 
hold  it  necessary  that  there  should  be  such 
a  power,  but  they  dispute  where  it  is. 
Some  affirm  that  a  man  ought  not  to  take 
upon  him  the  ministry  without  a  lawful 
call,  which  is  very  true.  They  likewise 
agree  that  ordination  ought  to  be  con- 
tinued, and  they  define  it  to  be  a  solemn 
setting  apart  of  some  person  to  a  church 
office ;  but  they  say  it  is  only  to  be  done 
by  preaching  presbyters,  and  that  those 
who  are  not  set  apart  themselves  for  the 
work  of  the  ministry,  have  no  power  to 
join  in  setting  apart  others  for  that  pur- 
pose ;  and  this  form  of  ordination  was  pro- 
posed to  the  parliament,  in  the  year  1643, 
by  an  assembly  of  those  persons,  in  order  tci 
be  ratified.  There  is  another  sort  of  peo- 
ple who  hold  that  where  there  are  no  such 
preaching  presbyters,  in  such  case,  other 
persons,  sufficiently  qualified  and  approved 
for  their  gifts  and  graces  by  other  minis- 


ORGAN 

ters,  being  clioscn  by  the  people,  and  set 
apart  for  the  ministry,  by  prayer  and  fasting 
in  the  congregation,  maj'  exercise  that  office, 
so  that  some  place  the  power  of  ordination 
in  simple  presbyters,  and  others  in  the  peo- 
ple. There  are  others  who  maintain  that 
ordination  is  not  to  be  justified  by  Scrip- 
ture, and  that  the  word  itself  signifies  a 
lifting  up  of  hands,  and  is  used  in  Scrip- 
ture for  giving  a  vote,  which  in  all  popular 
assemblies  is  customary  even  at  this  day  : 
from  whence  they  infer  that  the  Christian 
churches  were  at  first  democratical,  that 
is,  the  whole  congregation  chose  their  pas- 
tor ;  and  that  by  virtue  of  such  choice  he 
did  not  pretend  to  any  peculiar  jurisdic- 
tion distinct  from  others,  but  he  was  only 
approved  by  the  congregation  for  his  parts, 
and  appointed  to  instruct  the  people,  to 
visit  the  sick,  and  to  perform  all  other 
offices  of  a  minister,  and  at  other  times 
he  followed  his  trade ;  and  that  the  Chris- 
lians  in  those  days  had  no  notion  how  a 
pastor  could  pretend  to  any  succession  to 
qualify  him  for  the  ministry,  for  that  the 
pretence  of  dispensing  divine  things  by 
a  mere  human  constitution  was  such  an 
absurdity  that  it  could  not  be  reconciled  to 
reason. 

This  and  many  more  such  calumnies 
were  cast  on  ordination,  and  the  bishops 
themselves  were  called  ordination-mongers  ; 
but  it  was  by  those  who  alleged  that  the 
purity  of  the  Christian  religion,  and  the 
good  and  orderlj''  government  of  the  world, 
had  been  much  better  provided  for  without 
any  clergy.  But  it  has  been  already  shewn 
from  Scripture,  from  antiquity,  and  from 
the  concurrent  testimony  of  the  Fathers, 
that  the  bishops  had,  and  ought  to  have,  the 
power  of  ordination  (See  Apostolical  Siic- 
cession.  Ordinal,  Orders). 

II.  As  to  the  times  of  ordination,  by  the 
31st  canon  of  the  Church  of  England  it  is 
ordained :  "  Forasmuch  as  the  ancient 
Fathers  of  the  Church,  led  by  the  example 
of  the  apostles,  appointed  prayers  and  fasts 
to  be  used  at  the  solemn  ordaining  of  minis- 
ters, and  to  that  purpose  allotted  certain 
times,  in  which  only  sacred  orders  might  be 
given  and  conferred,  we,  following  their 
holy  and  religious  example,  do  constitute 
and  decree,  that  no  deacons  or  ministers  be 
made  or  ordained,  but  only  on  Sundays 
immediately  following /e/ania  quatuor  tem- 
pm-um,  commonly  called  Ember  Weeks, 
appointed  in  ancient  time  for  prayer  and 
fasting  (purposely  for  this  cause  at  the 
first  institution),  and  so  continued  at  this 
day  in  the  Church  of  England "  (See 
Ember  Days). 

ORGAN.  (Lat.  organum :  Gk.  opyavov). 
The  word  in  the  widest  sense  means  properly 
an  instrument  of  any  kind  by  which  some 


OEGAN 


551 


process  is  carried  on;  but  for  church  pur- 
poses it  implies  an  instrument  of  music, 
constructed  so  as  to  combine  the  effects  of 
many  different  instruments  in  one,  which 
the  Church  for  centuries  past  has  consecrated 
to  her  own  special  use. 

The  first  organs  were  hydraulic ;  but 
what  part  water  played  in  producing  sounds 
is  difficult  to  make  clear.  Vitruvius  (de 
ArcJiitectura,  bk.  x.  chap,  xi.,  in  Hopkins 
and  Eimbault,  pp.  6-8)  has  left  us  a  long 
description  of  such  an  organ ;  but  his 
account  is  cumbrous  and  unintelligible. 
This  much,  however,  is  certain,  that  the 
hydraulic  organ  was  provided  with  pipes 
and  a  wind-chest,  and  registered  like  the 
wind-organ.  This_  kind  of  organ  was  in- 
vented by  Ctesibiiis  of  Alexandria  about 
200  years  B.C.,  and  continued  in  use  as 
late  as  a.d.  850.  It  was  never  used  in  the 
Greek  Chmch.  Bellarmine  states,  though 
on  doubtful  authority,  that  in  660  Pope 
Vitalian  introduced  it  into  the  church  service 
at  Rome.  Mr.  Rimbault  says  that  it  was 
introduced  into  the  English  service  by 
Theodore  and  Adrian,  emissaries  of  Vitalian ; 
and  from  a  passage  in  the  writings  of 
Adhelm,  bishop  of  Sherborne,  who  died  in 
709,  it  appears  that  the  external  case  was 
gilt  (^auratis  capsis),  and  that  the  pipes  were 
numerous  (maxima  millenis  organa  fiahris). 
In  757,  the  Eastern  Emperor  Constantine 
Copronymus  sent  an  organ  to  Pepin,  which 
was  placed  in  a  church  at  Compeigne  (see 
Hamel,  Manuel  c/es  Facteurs  des  Orgues). 
In  811,  ambassadors  from  Constantinople 
brought  two  organs  to  Charlemagne;  but  > 
the  use  of  the  instrument  did  not  become 
common  till  the  middle  of  the  ninth  century, 
when  a  Venetian  priest  introduced  what  is 
supposed  to  be  an  hydraulic  organ.  About 
the  same  time  Louis  le  Debonaire  gave  an 
organ  to  the  cathedral  at  Aix  la  Chapelle. 
A  century  later,  Wulstan  relates  that 
-Elphege,  bishop  of  Winchester,  gave  an 
organ  to  the  cathedral  with  400  pipes,  40 
keys,  and  (if  his  meaning  is  clear)  26 
pairs  of  bellows,  played  by  two  organists. 
In  the  tenth  century,  Dunstan,  archbishop 
of  Canterbury,  gave  an  organ  to  Malmesbury, 
described  by  William  of  Malmesbury  as 
having  copper  pipes.  At  the  same  time  an 
organ  was  given  to  Ramsey  Church  with 
copper  pipes,  emitting  a  sweet  melody  and 
far-resounding  peal.  In  the  twelfth  century 
an  organ  is  mentioned  in  the  abbey  of 
Fecamp ;  and  Gervas  the  monk,  describing 
Canterbury  Cathedral  as  he  knew  it  before 
the  fire  in  1172,  says  that  it  had  arches 
"  to  carry  organs." 

These  instances  are  sufficient  to  shew  that 
organs  were  in  use  for  ecclesiastical  purposes 
at  a  very  early  date.  A  mediasval  phrase 
which  has  strangely  led  many  writers  astray 


552 


ORGAN 


is  a  "  pail-  of  organs."  The  commonest  in- 
terpretation is  that  it  must  have  meant  an 
organ  with  two  rows  of  keys.  But  such  an 
organ  was  always  described  as  a  double 
organ.  The  true  account  is  that  a  "  pair 
of  organs"  meant  simply  an  organ  with 
several  pipes.  Pepys,  describing  his  visit 
to  Hackney  Church,  speaks  of  "  a  fair  pair  of 
organs"  and  then  refers  in  the  singular 
number  to  "  it,"  fully  bearing  out  this  ex- 
planation of  the  term.  Jonson,  Heywood, 
and  other  of  the  older  poets,  always  use  the 
term  pair  in  the  sense  of  an  aggregate,  and 
as  synonymous  with  set:  thus  we  have  a 
"pair  of  chessmen,"  " pair  oi  heaAs,"  "pair 
of  cards."  When  speaking  of  a  flight  of 
.stairs,  we  often  say  a  "pair  of  stairs." 

Down  to  the  fourteenth  century  the  keys 
were  played  with  the  whole  fist,  just  as 
carillons  are  playtd;  but  about  that  time 
the  monks  set  about  improving  the  clumsy 
clavier.  They  made  neater  keys,  increased 
their  number  both  upwards  and  downwards 
to  the  extent  of  nearly  three  octaves,  and  so 
reduced  tlieir  fall  .and  breadth  that  they 
no  longer  required  to  be  struck  down  by  the 
fist,  but  were  capable  of  being  pressed  down 
by  the  fingers,  as  in  the  modern  organs. 
Towards  the  end  of  the  same  century  the 
pedal  was  invented.  Here  again  erroneous 
notions  have  long  prevailed,  as  this  invention 
is  commonly  ascribed  to  a  German  named 
Bernhard  who  was  organist  to  the  Doge  of 
Venice  in  1470  ;  but  from  certain  documents 
relating  to  a  church  at  Beeskow,  near  Frank- 
fort on  the  Oder,  it  is  beyond  question  that 
the  pedal  existed  as  early  as  1418. 

Many  of  the  early  organ-builders  were 
ecclesiastics,  and  the  art  flourished  at  first 
in  Germany.  But  it  is  certain  that  by  the 
beginning  of  the  sixteenth  century  there 
were  several  builders  of  repute  in  England. 
Their  labours  were,  however,  hindered  by 
the  jjuritanical  spirit,  which,  growing  up  in 
the  reign  of  Elizabeth,  found  a  violent  outlet 
in  the  decree  of  tbe  House  of  Lords,  dated 
June  4th,  1644,  and  doomed  all  existing 
organs  to  destruction.  The  general  intro- 
duction of  organs  into  London  parish  churches 
did  not  take  place  till  after  the  Eestora- 
tion.  Their  use  appears  never  to  have  been 
very  general,  even  in  cathedrals,  in  Ireland ; 
and  m  Scotland  it  is  supposed  that  they 
were  not  introduced  till  the  fil'teentli  cen- 
tury. 

The  Neo-Catholio  revival,  or  High  Church 
movement  as  it  is  sometimes  styled,  and  the 
remarkable  development  of  English  musical 
taste  during  the  last  quarter  of  a  century, 
have  combined  to  produce  a  great  amelio- 
ration in  the  conduct  of  the  musical  part  of 
our  church  services.  This  has  caused  a 
demand  for  a  number  of  organs  both  large 
and    small    throughout    the    land.      Most 


ORGANI&T 

cathedral  organs  have  been  rebuilt  or  re- 
placed by  more  modern  instruments  within 
the  last  twent}'  years,  and  there  is  scarcely 
a  parish  church  in  which  an  organ  has  not 
replaced  the  barrel  organ  or  strident  har- 
monium or  the  "  band  "  which  in  old  days 
used  to  perform  in  the  gallery.  The  part 
which  the  organ  plays  in  our  English  Church 
music  is  unique.  On  the  continent  it  is  used 
by  the  Roman  Catholics  only  on  feast  days 
and  their  eves,  and  then  commonly  on  the 
support  of  an  orchestra ;  in  Lutheian 
churches  it  merely  accompanies  the  chorales 
and  plays  the  voluntary.  Englisb  Church 
composers  make  large  demands  on  the  instru- 
ment, and  in  fact  there  are  some  churches 
where  the  organ  is  rarely  silent  during 
service.  There  should  be  a  mean,  however, 
between  allowing  the  service  to  be  dead  and 
cold,  and  giving  the  organ  undue  prominence, 
and  thus  producing  a  restless  feeling  in  the 
worshipper. 

As  to  the  best  position  for  the  organ  in  a 
church,  nothing  definite  can  be  laid  down. 
The  most  usual  position  assigned  to  the 
organ  in  continental  churches  for  the  last 
three  centuries,  has  been  the  west  end, 
probably  for  the  same  reason  that  the  end 
of  a  concert-room  is  the  best  place  for  am 
orchestra;  namely,  because  the  tone  could 
travel  in  several  directions,  and  could  be 
dispersed  throughout  the  building.  This 
position,  however,  does  not  suit  an  Englisli 
cathedral,  as  the  choir  would  then  be 
separated  from  the  organ  by  such  a  vass 
gap  in  space  that  co-operation  between  the 
two  would  be  practically  impossible.  Con- 
sequently many  organ  builders  have  built 
their  cathedral  organs  on  the  choir-screen. 
This  necessitated  a  heavy  screen  and  has  often 
been  condemned,  but  many  persons  still  con- 
sider it  the  most  effective  place,  though  it 
spoils  the  architecture  of  a  cathedral.  So  at 
a  later  stage,  the  organ  was  pushed  eastward 
once  more  at  the  east  end  of  an  aisle  or  a 
chancel  chapel,  or  again  in  cathedrals  where 
the  transepts  are  nearer  the  east  than  the 
west  end,  in  one  or  both  transepts.  It  is  to 
be  regretted  that  the  space  required  for  the 
organ  is  generally  doled  out  by  the  archi- 
tect without  previous  consultation  with  the 
organ-builder ;  and  this  is  why  many  an  in- 
strument is  either  not  large  enough  for  the 
church  it  is  required  to  fill  with  sound,  or 
else  owing  to  its  cramped  position  cannot 
do  itself  justice  (See  Eimbault  and  Hop- 
kins' exhaustive  treatise  on  the  Organ, 
published  by  Robert  Cocks  &  Co.,  London, 
18T0).     [W.  H.  D.] 

ORGANIST.  An  oificial  who  plays  upon 
the  organ.  The  more  ancient  names  for  the 
person  who  held  this  ofiice  were  master  of 
the  song  school,  clerk  of  the  chapel,  and 
in  the  13th  century  at  Hereford  clerk  of 


OBIGENISTS 

the  organs.  He  ranked  as  a  vicar-choral,  and 
usually  was  also  master  of  the  clioristers. 
At  Durham  a  monk  played  at  nocturns  and 
matins,  and  the  master  of  the  song  school 
at  high  mass  and  vespers.  In  most  cathe- 
drals and  choral  foundations  the  organist 
combines  the  duty  of  training  the  choir 
with  that  of  playing  the  organ ;  but  he  is 
not  generally  a  member  of  the  collegiate 
body. 

ORIGENISTS.  Heretics  in  the  fourth 
century,  so  called  because  they  pretended 
to  draw  their  opinions  from  the  writings  of 
the  famous  Origen,  a  priest  of  Alexandria. 
Origen  himself  was  pupil  and  successor  to 
St.  Clement  in  the  school  of  Alexandria. 
He  was  an  ascetic  of  extreme  type,  but  a 
man  of  untiring  energy  and  work  (Euseb. 
H.  E.  vi.  3,  26).  He  complains  that  his 
ideas  were  perverted  {Horn.  xxv.  in  Luc.). 
And  there  is  no  doubt  that  his  works  were 
corrupted  by  heretics  at  a  very  early  period, 
and  wrested  to  their  particular  ideas. 

The  Origenists  made  their  first  appear- 
ance in  Italy  in  397.  Kufinus  of  Aquileia, 
a  priest  of  Alexandria,  had  studied  the  works 
of  Origen  with  so  much  apiDlication,  that  he 
adopted  that  writer's  supposed  Platonic 
notions  for  Catholic  truths.  Full  of  these 
ideas,  he  went  to  Jerusalem,  where  Origen 
had  a  great  many  partisans.  There  he 
made  his  court  to  Melania,  a  Roman  lady, 
who  had  embraced  Origen's  opinions. 
Aftei'wards  he  came  to  Rome  with  this 
lady,  who  was  greatly  esteemed  in  that 
city.  Here  he  set  out  with  an  outward 
show  of  simplicity,  and  pretended,  after 
the  example  of  Origen,  an  universal  con- 
tempt of  all  worldly  things.  This  made 
him  looked  upon  as  one  who  Uved  up  to 
the  highest  Christian  perfection.  Rufinus 
took  advantage  of  this  prejudice  in  his 
favour  to  propagate  his  opinions,  in  which 
the  credit  of  Melania  was  of  great  use  to 
him.  And  now  he  began  to  have  a  great 
number  of  followers,  and  to  form  a  con- 
siderable sect.  But  another  Roman  lady, 
named  Marcella,  having  acquainted  Pope 
Anastasius,  that  Rufinus  and  Melania  were 
spreading  very  dangerous  opinions  in 
Rome,  under  the  veil  of  piety,  the  holy 
father  examined  into  the  fact,  and  forbade 
them  to  teach  any  more.  Rufinus  and 
Melania  submitted  to  the  prohibition ; 
Melania  returned  to  Jerusalem,  and  Ru- 
finus to  Aquileia.  However,  the  opinions 
they  had  broached  continued  to  be  main- 
tained and  defended  by  many  learned 
men,  who  were  therefore  distinguished  by 
the  name  of  Origenists. 

The  errors  ascribed  to  the  Origenists  are 
in  number  nine,  and  are  as  follows  : — 

1.  The  souls  of  men  were  holy  intelli- 
gences, who  enjoyed  the  presence  of  God ; 


ORIGINAL  SIN 


653 


but  being  tired  with  the  Divine  contempla- 
tion, they  degenerated ;  and  as  their  first 
fervour  was  greatly  abated,  the  Greeks 
therefore  called  the  soul  vovs,  from  the  word 
voativ,  which  signifies  to  slacken  or  grow 
cold. 

Our  Saviour's  soul  was  united  to  the 
Word,  before  his  conception,  and  before  He 
was  born  of  the  Holy  Virgin. 

3.  The  body  of  our  Saviour  Jesus  Christ 
was  first  formed  entire  in  the  Virgin's 
womb ;  and  afterwards  His  soul,  which  long 
before  had  been  united  to  the  Word,  came- 
and  was  joined  to  it. 

4.  The  AVord  of  God  has  been  successively 
united  with  aU  the  angelical  natures ;  in- 
somuch that  it  has  been  a  cherub,  seraph, 
and  all  the  celestial  virtues,  one  after  an- 
other. 

5.  After  the  resurrection,  the  bodies  of 
men  will  be  of  a  spherical  figure,  and  not  of 
their  present  erect  stature. 

6.  Tlie  heavens,  sun,  moon,  and  stars, 
are  animated  bodies,  and  have  an  intelli^ 
gent  soul. 

7.  In  future  ages,  our  Saviour  Jesus 
Christ  will  be  crucified  for  the  salvation  of 
the  devils,  as  he  has  already  been  for  that 
of  men. 

8.  The  power  of  God  is  not  infinite,  and 
was  so  exhausted  in  the  creation  of  things, 
that  he  has  no  more  left. 

9.  The  punishment  of  the  devils,  and  of 
the  damned,  will  continue  only  for  a  certain, 
limited  time. 

These  nine  errors  are  distinctly  recited 
by  the  second  Council  of  Constantinople  at 
the  end  of  a  letter  of  the  emperor  Justinian 
against  Origen.  The  recital  of  them  is  im- 
mediately followed  by  an  anathema  against 
Origen,  and  all  who  maintained  his  opi- 
nions :  in  which  it  is  remarkable  that  the 
council  exconamunicated  Origen  near  three- 
hundred  years  after  his  death. 

The  heresy  of  the  Origenists  spread 
widely  in  Egypt,  and  especially  among  the 
monks.  Several  eminent  bishops  opposed 
them,  particularly  Theophilus,  bishop  of 
Alexandria,  who,  in  the  year  399,  assembled 
a  council  in  that  city,  in  which  the  monks 
inhabiting  the  mountain  of  Nitria,  wera 
condemned  as  Origenists. 

Avitus,  a  Spanish  priest,  revived  tho- 
errors  of  the  Origenists  in  Spain,  about  the 
year  415 :  and  probably  it  was  against  the 
followers  of  this  Avitus  that  the  Council  of 
Toledo  was  held  in  633. — Huet's  Origeniana, 
i.  iii.  10  ■,  Walch,  Eist.  Ecdes.  N.  T.  p. 
1042  seq. 

ORIGINAL  SIN.  The  term  is  derived 
from  a  passage  in  St.  Augustine :  "  Nas- 
cuntur  non  proprii,  sed  originaliter,  pecca- 
tores  "  (De  Civit.  lib.  16,  c.  18).  Our  article- 
(ix.)  thus  explains  it : 


554 


OEIGINAL  SIN 


"  Oiigmal  sin  standeth  not  in  the  follow- 
ing of  Adam  (as  the  Pelagians  do  vainly 
talk) ;  but  it  is  the  fault  and  corruption  of 
the  nature  of  every  man  that  naturally  is 
engendered  of  the  offspring  of  Adam; 
whereby  man  is  very  far  gone  from  original 
righteousness,  and  is  of  his  o^vn  nature  in- 
•cMned  to  evU,  so  that  the  flesh  lusteth  always 
contrary  to  the  spirit;  and  therefore  in 
every  person  born  into  this  world,  it  de- 
serveth  God's  wrath  and  damnation.  And 
this  infection  of  nature  doth  remain,  yea,  in 
them  that  are  regenerated ;  whereby  the  lust 
of  the  flesh,  called  in  the  Greek  phronema 
sarkos,  which  some  do  expound  the  wisdom, 
some  sensuality,  some  the  affection,  some 
the  desire  of  the  flesh,  is  not  subject  to  the 
law  of  God.  And  although  there  is  no  con- 
■demnation  for  them  that  believe,  and  are 
baptized"  [renatis,  i.e.  born  again,  is  the 
word  used  in  the  Latin  copy],  "  yet  the 
apostle  doth  confess,  that  concupiscence  and 
lust  hath  of  itself  the  nature  of  sin."  This 
article  was  intended  to  oppose  the  notion  of 
the  School  divines,  who  maintained  that  the 
infection  of  our  nature  is  not  a  mental,  but 
a  mere  corporeal  taint ;  that  the  body  alone 
receives  and  transmits  the  contagion,  while 
the  soul  proceeds,  in  all  cases,  immaculate 
from  the  hands  of  the  Creator.  Original 
sin  they  directly  opposed  to  original  right- 
eousness, and  this  they  considered,  not  as 
something  connatural  with  man,  but  as  a 
superinduced  habit,  or  adventitious  orna- 
ment, the  removal  of  which  could  not  prove 
detrimental  to  the  native  powers  of  the 
mind.  Thus  the  School  divines  maintained, 
in  opposition  to  our  Articles,  that  the  lapse 
of  Adam  conveys  to  us  solely  imputed  guilt, 
the  corporeal  iiifection  which  they  admitted, 
not  being  sin  itself,  but  the  subject  matter  ; 
not  peccdtum,  hut  fames  peccdti.  The  Lu- 
therans taught  that  original  sin  is  a  corrup- 
tion of  our  nature  in  a  general  sense,  the  de- 
pravation of  the  mental  faculties  and  the 
corporeal  appetites.  The  Calvinists  main- 
tain that  lust  and  concupiscence  are  truly 
and  properly  sin. 

The  Scriptures  teach  us  that  the  sin  of 
Adam  not  only  made  him  hable  to  death, 
but  that  it  also  changed  the  upright  nature 
in  which  he  was  originally  formed,  into  one 
that  was  prone  to  wickedness ;  and  that 
this  liability  to  death,  and  propensity  to  sin, 
were  entailed  from  him  upon  the  whole  race 
of  mankind :  "  By  one  man  sin  entered  into 
the  world,  and  death  by  sin ;  and  so  death 
passed  upon  all  men,  for  that  all  have  sinned  " 
(Rom.  V.  12).  It  is  not  necessary  to  quote 
the  many  passages  in  Holy  Scripture  loear- 
ing  upon  the  sinfulness  of  our  nature,  such 
as  "  the  heart  is  deceitful  above  all  things, 
and  desperately  wicked  "  (Jer.  xvii.  9),  &c. 
It  is  called  "  the  sin  that  dwelleth  in  us  " 


ORNAMENTS 

(Rom.  vii.  17) ;  "  the  body  of  sin  "  (vi.  6)  ; 
"the  law  of  sin  and  death"  (viii.  2); 
"  lust "  (vii.  7) ;  "  the  sin  which  so  easily 
besets  us "  (Heb.  xii.  1) ;  "  the  flesh " 
(Gal.  V.  16) ;  "  the  old  man"  (Eph.  iv.  22)  ; 
"  the  likeness  of  Adam"  (Gen.  v.  3).  The 
subject  is  exhaustively  treated  by  Bishop 
Jeremy  Taylor  (Works,  vol.  ix.,  Heber's  ed). 

ORNAMENTS    OF    THE    CHURCH." 
The  earliest  legislation  on  this  subject  is 
the  statute,  commonly  called  by  its  initial 
words  Circumpecte  agatis,  of  13  Ed.  I.  st.  4. 

"  The  king  to  his  judges  sendeth  greeting. 
Use  yourselves  circumspectly  in  all  matters 
relating  to  the  bishops  of  [Norwich]  when 
they  do  punish  for  that  the  church  is  not 
conveniently  decked:  in  which  case  the 
spiritual  judge  shall  have  power  to  take 
knowledge  notwithstanding  the  king's  pro- 
hibition." All  the  modern  law  on  this  sub- 
ject depends  on  the  much-discussed  orna- 
ments rubric  at  the  beginning  of  the  Prayer 
Book,  which  includes  also  the  ornaments  of 
the  clergy,  and  that  has  been  sufficiently  dealt 
with  already  under  the  Advertisements  of 
Queen  Elizabeth,  as  they  are  commonly  called. 
There  is  not  nor  ever  was  any  rubrical  or 
statutable  deflnition  of  ornaments  of  the 
church,  as  there  was  of  the  clergy.  They 
have  to  be  gathered  from  what  is  prescribed 
or  omitted  in  various  parts  of  the  Prayer 
Book,  and  by  the  history  of  what  was  in  use 
by  authority  of  Parliament  in  the  second 
year  of  Edward  VI.  For  the  Advertisements 
did  not  affect  them,  as  it  has  been  several 
times  decided  that  they  did  affect  the  vest- 
ments, by  virtue  of  the  Act  of  Uniformity 
of  1  Eliz.  The  rubric  inserted  by  somebody 
in  the  Prayer  Book  of  Elizabeth  was  an 
illegal  and  partial  copy  of  a  clause  in  that 
Act.  There  was  no  "  sealed  book  "  of  that 
Prayer  Book. 

Lawful  ornaments  of  the  church  may  be 
defined  with  sufficient  accuracy  to  mean  all 
things  therein  which  are  either  necessary  or 
convenient  for  use  or  for  lawful  decoration. 

What  is  lawful  of  course  depends  upon 
the  law,  and  a  judicial  decision  if  any 
question  is  raised  about  it.  Of  course  also 
a  thing  which  is  plainly  ornamental  m  it- 
self may  be  unlawful.  And  the  word  has 
legally  a  still  wider  meaning  apart  from  the 
question  whether  the  thing  is  ornamental 
in  the  common  sense  or  not.  Thus  all  ser- 
vice books  are  legally  ornaments,  though 
hardly  decorations. 

The  Privy  Council  decided  that  "  things 
used  in  the  performance  of  the  services  and 
rites  of  the  church  are  ornaments  "  in  Idddell 
V.  Westerton  (Ecc.  Judgments  of  P.  C.) ;  and 
that  there  is  a  clear  distinction  between  the 
presence  of  things  inert  and  unused,  and  the 
active  use  of  them  in  the  service  ;  and  that 
such  things  as  organs,  cushions,  and  the  like, 


ORTHODOXY 

and  a  credence  table  or  shelf  from  wliicli  the 
elements  are  taken  to  put  on  the  table  at  the 
prescribed  time,  are  lawful  because  useful 
or  necessary,  or  implied  or  referred  to  by  any 
rubric  or  canon.  No  limitation  was  put  on 
church  ornaments,  as  was  on  vestments,  by 
the  Advertisements,  which  the  Privy  Council 
has  twice  decided  to  have  been  the  "  taking 
order  by  authority  of  the  queen  "  as  provided 
for  by  her  Act  of  Uniformity  (but  see  Adver- 
tisements). Crosses  have  been  decided  to 
be  lawful  when  they  are  bona  fide  archi- 
tectural ornaments  of  the  church,  but  not 
as  appendages  to  the  communion  table 
whether  fixed  or  loose  (see  Crosses),  but 
crucifixes  to  be  entirely  illegal,  except  as 
part  of  a  group  of  statuary  (see  Crucifix). 
Altar  cloths  for  the  communion  service 
must  be  of  plain  linen  without  lace  and 
fringes,  which  are  only  copied  from  Roman 
use;  and  the  silk  cloths  for  other  times 
are  te  be  subject  to  the  approval  of  the 
ordinary,  according  to  canon  82.  Super- 
altars,  baldachinos  (see  them),  banners  or 
crosses  carried  in  procession,  flowers  on  the 
table,  the  use  of  incense,  steps  round  the 
table,  or  any  which  make  it  look  like  an 
altar  (which  would  not  apply  to  a  single 
step  all  along  in  front  of  it),  lighted  candles 
.-(;on  the  table  when  not  wanted  for  light, 
chancel-gates  and  close  screens,  have  all 
been  condemned  as  illegal;  and  on  other 
grounds,  stone  altars  instead  of  wooden 
tables,  mixing  water  with  the  wine,  and 
wafers  instead  of  bread,  though  people  seem 
to  be  at  liberty  to  cut  the  bread  into  rounds 
instead  of  squares  if  they  choose  ;  but  it 
must  be  common  bread.  And  the  Privy 
Council  repudiated  the  theory  of  Sir  E. 
Phillimore,  Dean  of  Arches,  that  the  rubrics 
and  canons  are  to  be  understood  as  only 
prescribing  the  minimum  of  ornaments  or 
ceremonies,  but  allowing  the  maximum 
which  is  not  expressly  forbidden. 

A  second  communion  table  in  an  aisle 
3aas  also  been  condemned  as  unauthorised 
by  any  rubric  or  canon.  But  where  quite 
<iifferent  parts  of  the  church  are  hona  fide 
used  for  large  and  small  congregations,  or  for 
cathedral  and  parochial  services,  two  tables 
would  no  doubt  be  allowed.  In  one  cathedral 
and  perhaps  more,  there  are  three  in  distant 
places,  separated  by  stone  screens,  which 
make  three  distinct  churches.  On  the  other 
hand,  some  have  been  put  up  in  aisles  of 
small  churches,  with  no  pretence  of  either 
necessity  or  utility,  but  in  obvious  imitation 
of  popish  use  (See  Monuments,  Painted 
Windows,  Commandments).     [G.] 

ORTHODOXY  (;Op66s  and  SoACfo). 
Literally  "  upright  thinking,"  and  so  sound- 
ness of  doctrine. 

Of  course  the  question  here  to  be  decided 
is.  What  is  soundness  of  doctrine  ?     If  two 


OUTWARD 


555 


men  take  Scripture  for  their  guide,  and  pro- 
fessing to  have  no  other  guide,  come  to 
opposite  conclusions,  it  is  quite  clear  that 
neither  has  a  right  to  decide  that  the  other 
is  not  orthodox.  On  this  principle  it  is  as 
uncharitable  and  illogical  for  the  Trinitarian 
to  call  the  Socinian  not  orthodox,  as  it  is 
for  the  Socinian  to  predicate  the  same  of  the 
Trinitarian.  But  if  we  interpret  Scripture 
by  the  sense  of  the  Church,  as  declared  in 
the  general  councils  of  the  first  five  centuries, 
in  primitive  creeds  and  liturgies,  and  by 
the  concurrent  testimony  of  early  writers, 
then  we  may  consistently  call  those  ortho- 
dox who  hold  the  doctrines  which  she 
deduces  from  Scripture,  and  those  heterodox 
who  do  not  hold  those  doctrines.  So  that 
orthodoxy  means  soundness  of  doctrine,  the 
doctrine  being  proved  to  be  sound  by  refer- 
ence to  the  consentient  testimony  of  Scrip- 
ture and  the  Church. 

ORTLIBENSES.  A  sect,  or  branch,  of 
the  ancient  Vaudois  or  Waldenses,  after- 
wards known  as  the  Brethren  of  the  Free 
Spirit. 

They  appear  to  have  been  disciples  of 
Amalric,  of  Bema,  and  Ortlieb  of  Strasburg, 
early  in  the  13th  century.  The  Ortlibenses 
denied  there  was  a  Trinity  before  the  na- 
tivity of  Jesus  Christ,  who,  according  to 
them,  was  not  till  that  time  the  Son  of  God. 
To  these  two  persons  of  the  Godhead  they 
added  a  third,  during  the  preaching  of  Jesus 
Christ ;  namely,  St.  Peter,  whom  they  ac- 
knowledged to  be  the  Holy  Ghost.  They 
held  the  eternity  of  the  world  ;  but  had  no 
notion  of  the  resurrection  of  the  body,  or  the 
immortality  of  the  soul.  Notwithstanding 
which,  they  maintained  (perhaps  by  way  of 
irony)  that  there  would  be  a  final  judgment, 
at  which  time  the  pope  and  the  emperor 
would  become  proselytes  to  their  sect. 

They  denied  the  death  and  resurrection 
of  Jesus  Christ.  His  cross,  they  pretended, 
was  penance,  like  their  own  abstemious  waj' 
of  life :  this,  they  said,  was  the  cross  our 
Saviour  bore.  They  ascribed  all  the  virtue 
of  baptism  to  the  merit  of  him  who  admin- 
istered it.  They  were  of  opinion  that  Jews 
might  be  saved  without  baptism,  provided 
they  embraced  their  sect.  They  boldlj"- 
asserted  that  they  themselves  were  the  only 
true  mystical  body,  that  is  to  say,  the 
Church  of  Christ. — Reiner,  Bihl.  Max.  xxv. 
266 ;  Gieseler,  Compend.  Eccl.  Hist.  iii. 
67,  Clark's  ed. 

OUR  LADY.  The  old  English  designa- 
tion of  the  Blessed  Virgin  Mary.  The  term 
is  retained  in  our  own  Table  of  Lessons, 

OUTWARD  AND  VISIBLE  SIGN. 
Part  of  the  definition  of  the  word  Sacrament. 
It  is  attributed  to  Peter  Lombard,  called 
the  "  Master  of  the  Sentences,"  in  the  12th 
century  (See  Sacrament). 


556 


PACIFICATION 


P. 

'  PACIFICATION,  EDICTS  OF,  were 
decrees  or  edicts,  granted  by  the  kings  of 
France  to  the  Protestants,  for  appeasing  the 
troubles  occasioned  by  their  persecution. 

The  first  edict  of  pacification  was  granted 
by  Charles  IX.,  in  January,  1562,  per- 
mitting the  free  exercise  of  the  reformed 
religion  near  all  the  cities  and  towns  of  the 
realm.  On  March  19,  1563,  the  same  king 
granted  a  second  edict  of  pacification  at 
Amboise ;  and  another,  called  the  edict  of 
Lonjuraeau,  ordering  the  execution  of  that 
of  Amboise,  was  published  March  27,  1558, 
after  a  treaty  of  jieace.  Nevertheless,  in 
August,  1572,  Charles  authorised  the  Bar- 
tholomew massacre,  and  at  the  same  time 
issued  a  declaration,  forbidding  the  exercise 
of  the  Protestant  religion.  Henry  III.  also 
published  edicts  of  pacification,  but  was 
violently  opposed  by  the  Guise  faction, 
which  established  the  famous  league  for 
defence  of  the  Catholic  religion,  and  in  1585 
obtained  an  edict  revoking  all  former  con- 
cessions to  the  Protestants,  and  ordering 
them  to  depart  the  kingdom  in  six  months, 
or  turn  Papists.  This  edict  was  followed 
by  more  to  the  same  purpose.  Henry  IV. 
had  similar  difficulties  in  the  way  of  pacifi- 
cation, but  in  1598  he  published  a  new  edict 
at  Nantes,  granting  the  Protestants  the  free 
exercise  of  their  religion,  and  making  them 
eligible  for  all  civil  and  military  employ- 
ments. This  edict  of  Nantes  was  confirmed 
by  Louis  XIII.  in  1610,  and  by  Louis  XIV. 
in  1652.  But  his  letter,  in  1685,  abolished 
it  entirely,  since  which  time  the  Protestants 
ceased  to  be  tolerated  in  France  till  the 
Revolution. — Broughton,  Biblio.  vol.  ii.  p. 
109 ;  Jervis,  Hist,  of  Church  of  France. 

PACIFIC^.  A  name  given  in  early  times 
to  the  Litanies,  as  they  contained  supplica- 
tions for  peace. — Neale's  East.  Ch.,  Int. 
p.  360. 

PACIFIC.^;  BPISTOL.^;  (See  Letters 
J)'i'tYi/iss(yr^t 

P^DO-BAPTISM  (From  Tralr,  a  child, 
and  /San-Tiffu/,  to  baptize).  The  baptism  of 
children  (See  Baptism  of  Infants'). 

PAINTED  GLASS  WINDOWS  (See 
Windows). 

PALL  or  PALLIUM.  The  word  pal- 
lium properly  signifies  a  cloak  thrown  over 
the  shoulders.  It  was  worn  by  the  Romans 
as  a  mark  of  distinction :  "  Consularis  homo 
soccos  habuit  et  pallium "  (^Cic.  Bab.  Post. 
10).  Afterwards  it  came  to  denote  a  sort 
of  cape  or  tippet,  and  hence  the  ecclesias- 
tical designation  in  the  Western  Church. 

The  antiquity  of  the  use  of  the  pall  as 


PALL"] 

an  ecclesiastical  vestment,  and  its  original 
shape,  is  obscure.  An  old  writer  sjys : 
"  Quando  et  quomodo  usus  illius  ornamenti 
incajpeiit  sat  obscurum  est, ,  sive  Gra-cam 
sive  Latinam  ecclesiam  specteinus"  (Van 
Espiu,  Jus  Eccles.  torn.  i.  p.  169).  .,  But 
whoever  considers  the  ancient  figures  of  it 
which  are  found  in  manuscripts,  &c.,  will 
see  that  it  was  originally  only  a  stole  wound 
round  the  neck,  with  the  ends  hanging 
down  behind  and  before.  In  the  East  the 
pall  is  called  omophorion,  and  has  beei> 
used,  at  least,  since  the  time  of  Chrysostom. 
It  is  used  by  all  the  Eastern  bishops,  above 
the  phenolion  or  vestment,  during  the  Eu- 
charist; and,  as  used  by  them,  resembles 
the  ancient  pall  much  more  nearly  than 
that  worn  by  the  Western  metropolitans. — 
Palmer,  Orig.  Liturg.  ii.  317. 

The  pall  is  described  as  consisting  of 
a  strip  of  woollen  cloth  worn  across  the 
shoulders,  to  which  are  appended  two  other 
strips  of  the  same  material,  one  of  them 
falling  over  the  breast,  and  the  other  hang- 
ing down  the  back,  each  marked  with  a  red 
or  purple  cross,  and  the  whole  tacked  on  to 
the  rest  of  the  dress  by  three  golden  pins 
(Sec  Innocent  III.'s  description :  De  Miss, 
Myst.  i.  c.  63).  Originally  it  was  worn 
by  the  emperors,  and  might  not  be  adopted 
by  any  one  else  without  special  consent. 
This  consent  was  occasionally  given,  as  a 
mark  of  favour,  to  philosophers  and  men  of 
learning  ;  and  in  process  of  time  the  honom- 
was  conferred  upon  eminent  churchmen  by 
the  emperors,  especially  upon  the  patriarchs, 
including  the  bLshop  of  Rome.  Shortly 
before  the  time  of  Gregory  the  Great,  the 
popes  of  Rome  were  permitted  to  grant  the 
pallium  to  prelates  of  the  Western  Church,, 
but  only  with  the  imperial  sanction.  It 
was  not  then  the  mark  of  the  metropolitan 
dignity,  for  it  was  conferred  also  on  suffragan 
bishops ;  nor  was  it  an  emblem  of  authority, 
nor  a  token  of  dependence  upon  the  Roman 
see — it  was  simply  a  mark  of  favour.  The 
metropolitans  indeed  of  France  wore  a 
pallium,  but  not  the  Roman — it  was  called 
the  Gallican  pallium  (De  Marca.  lib.  vi> 
c.  7,31).  And  our  earlier  archbishops  sought 
it  as  an  honour,  they  did  not  receive  it  as  a 
pledge  of  servitude.  But  by  a  canon  passed 
in  the  Council  of  Lateran  a.d.  1215,  and 
afterwards  transcribed  into  the  decretals,  it 
was  enacted  that  the  pall  should  be  regarded 
as  a  mark  of  the  fulness  of  the  apostolic 
power,  and  an  oath  of  allegiance  to  the  pope 
was  to  be  taken.  Since  then,  in  the  Roman 
Church,  the  pope  alone  always  wears  the 
pallium,  and  wherever  he  ofiiciates,  to 
signify  his  assumed  authority  over  all  other 
particular  churches.  Archbishops  and 
patriarchs  receive  it  from  him,  and  cannot 
wear  it,  except  in  their  own  churches,  and 


PALL 

only  on  certain  great  festivals  when  they 
celebrate  the  mass.  Archbishop  Cranmer 
refused  to  wear  the  pallium,  regarding  it  as 
a  badge  of  Rome;  yet  in  1545  (after  the 
breach  with  Rome)  he  gave  a  pall  to  Hold- 
gate,  archbishop  of  York  (Hook's  ArcJi- 
hishops,  i.  28  :  viii.  326.  See  Maskell's  Mon. 
Hit.  ii.,  cxlvi.). 

The  pall  is  still  retained  as  an  heraldic 
ensign,  in  the  arms  of  the  archbishops  of 
Canterbury,  Armagh,  and  Dublin,  and  for- 
merly of  the  archbishop  of  York  also.    [H.] 

PALL  (Prom  Lat.  Folia,  a  garment, 
and  then  a  curtain  or  covering).  The  word 
is  frequently  used  to  denote  the  altar  cloth ; 
thus  Optatus  speaks  of  washing  the  "pallas  " 
(lib.  vi.  p.  98) ;  and  another  early  writer 
speaks  with  natural  horror  of  a  vandal  who 
had  taken  the  "  palls  of  the  altar,"  to  make 
garments  for  himself  (Victor,  de  Persec. 
Vandal,  lib.  i.  p.  593).  The  pall  did  not 
only  mean  the  linen  cloth,  but  also  cover- 
ings of  richer  material.  Ladies  sometimes 
gave  up  their  rich  silks  to  provide  coverings, 
or  palls,  for  the  altar  (Palladius,  Hist. 
Lausiac.  c.  119).  And  Constantine,  among 
other  splendid  gifts,  gave  a  royal  pall  for  the 
altar  in  his  church  at  Jerusalem  (Theodor. 
lib.  i.  c.  31).  In  more  modern  times  the 
frontal  or  antependium  was  much  decorated. 
In  1630,  at  Worcester  Cathedral,  the  upper 
and  lower  fronts,  and  the  pall,  or  middle 
covering,  are  mentioned ;  and  there  is  one 
with  the  acts  of  the  saints  of  the  fifteenth 
century  embroidered  on  it  at  Steejile  Aston, 
Oxon.  (Walcott's  Sac.  Arch.  p.  420).  At 
the  coronation  service  the  sovereign  makes 
an  oblation  of  a  pall,  or  altar  cloth  of  gold 
(See  Oblation). 

The  word  pall  also  is  used  for  the  cloth 
which,  according  to  custom,  is  placed  over 
and  covers  the  coffin  before  burial.  It  has 
generally  been  made  of  black  material,  but 
it  was  not  always  so.  In  1386  Lord 
Neville's  coffin  had  a  russet  pall  ensigned 
with  a  red  cross.  A  pall  is  preserved  by 
the  Clothiers'  Company  at  Worcester,  made 
of  two  copes  of  the  early  part  of  the  reign  of 
Henry  VII.  As  the  hope  of  the  resurrection 
ti  life  eternal  divests  the  funeral  of  the  idea 
of  sombreness,  it  is  now  frequently  the 
custom  to  cover  the  coflSn  with  a  violet  or 
purple  pall,  with  a  cross  of  white  or  gold 
upon  it.     [H.] 

PALM  SUNDAY.  The  Sunday  next 
before  Easter,  so  called  from  palm  branches 
being  strewed  on  the  road  by  the  multitude, 
when  our  Saviour  made  his  triumphal  entry 
into  Jerusalem. 

This,  the  first  day  of  Holy  Week,  was 
in  very  early  times  called  the  Sunday  of 
Palms.  In  the  Sacramentary  of  Gregory  it 
has  its  place  as  "  Dominica  in  ramis  palma- 
rum,"  but  it  was  probably  observed  under 


PALM  SUNDAY 


557 


that  name,  or  the  equivalent  in  Greek,  loner 
before.  The  /Sd'taji'  ioprfi,  the  feast  of  palms, 
is  mentioned  in  the  life  of  Euthymius,  a.d. 
470 ;  and  St.  Chrysostom  speaks  of  the 
shaking  of  palms  (a-tUiv  ra  /SaVa)  as  a 
custom  of  the  day.  But  it  is  doubtful  when 
the  benediction  of  the  palms,  with 'the 
"procession  of  palms,"  was  first  observed. 
It  does  not  seem  to  be  of  ancient  date,  for 
it  is  not  mentioned  in  the  early  sacra- 
mentaries  {Liturg.  Rom.  Vet.  Muratori,  i. 
546 :  ii.  51.  See  also  Ordo  Rom.  in  Mus. 
Ital.  ii.  18,  30).  But  in  later  or  mediaeval 
times  the  blessing  of  the  palms,  and  dis- 
tributing them  to  the  people,  was  attended 
with  great  ceremony.  The  palms  were  laid 
upon  the  altar,  and  the  priest  pronounced 
over  them  an  exorcism  and  a  blessing,  with 
prayers,  and  then  they  were  carried  in 
procession  round  the  church  (Goar,  745 ; 
Euchologion,  744). 

In  the  lectionary  of  St.  Jerome,  and  by 
other  writers,  this  Sunday  is  called  Indul- 
gence Sunday;  which  has  sometimes  been 
explained  by  the  custom  practised  by  the 
Christian  emperors  of  freeing  prisoners  and 
closing  the  courts  of  law  during  Holy  Week. 
But  from  the  words  in  the  proper  preface  for 
the  day  in  the  Gregorian  Sacramentary, 
"per  quem  (i.e.  Jesum)  nobis  indulgentia 
largitur,"  we  may  refer  the  term  rather  to 
the  "  indulgence  "  or  forbearing  love  of  om- 
Lord  in  going  forward  of  His  own  will  on 
this  day  to  ujeet  His  suffeiings.  It  is  also 
caUed  "  Great  Sunday,"  as  the  week  is  the 
"  great  week  " ;  "  Hosanna  Sunday,"  in  East- 
ern and  Southern  Europe ;  "  Olive  Sunday," 
in  Italy ;  "  Branch  Sunday"  {Dominica  hron- 
cJiarii),  in  Spain  and  Portugal ;  "  Sallow 
Sunday,"  in  Russia ;  "  Flower  Sundajf,"  or 
"  Willow  Sunday,"  in  parts  of  England  and 
Wales.  And  many  ancient  customs  are  still 
observed,  as  at  Malmesbury,  where  people 
go  in  procession  carrying  catkins  of  the 
willow  to  St.  Martin's  hill  on  this  day. 
Bede,  in  speaking  of  the  custom  of  carrying 
palms,  says :  "  Ramos  debent  fideles  portare, 
id  est  bona  opera"  (Tom.  vii.  p.  369). 
But  in  later  times  many  ceremonies  tending 
to  superstition  were  added  to  the  ancient 
simple  rite,  and  in  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549 
the  Benediction  of  the  Palms  was  set  aside, 
and  the  Epistle  and  Gospel  were  altered  ac- 
cordingly. The  collect  for  the  day,  which 
is  translated  with  slight  variations  from 
that  in  the  Sarum  Use,  puts  us  in  mind  of 
the  tender  love  of  God  towards  mankind  in 
sending  His  Son,  not  only  to  take  upon  Him 
our  flesh,  but  to  suffer  in  it  the  death  of  the 
cross  for  our  sins ;  to  the  intent  "  that  all 
mankind  should  follow  the  example  of  His 
great  humility ; "  and  thence  teaches  us  to 
pray,  "  that  we  may  both  follow  the  example 
of  His  patience,  and  also  be  made  partakers 


558 


PANTHEISM 


of  His  resurrection."  Tlie  Epistle  for  the 
day  presents  us  to  this  purpose  -with  the 
highest  and  best  pattern  for  our  imitation, 
even  the  Son  of  God,  who  hath  done  and 
suffered  all  these  great  things  for  us. 

This  Gospel,  with  the  others  that  follow 
on  each  day  of  this  holy  week,  give 
the  account  of  the  death  and  passion 
of  our  Blessed  Saviour,  together  with  the 
many  circumstances  that  went  before  and 
came  after  it. — Fuller's  Church  Hist.  p. 
222 ;  Walcott's  Sac.  Arch. ;  Brand's  Antiq. 
p.  236;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant;  Annot.  P.  B. 
i.  96.     [H.] 

PANTHEISM  (Uav,  all;  Qeos,  Ood). 
A  subtle  kind  of  atheism,  which  identifies 
the  Deity  with  the  universe,  and  so  denies 
the  existence  and  sovereignty  of  any  God 
over  the  universe.  It  is  to  be  feared  that 
much  of  the  mere  natural  religion  of  the 
present  day  partakes  of  the  character  of 
Pantheism.  It  has  been  shown,  and  no  at- 
tempt has  been  made  to  refute  it,  that  all 
theories  of  "  automatic  cosmogony  "  or  self- 
existing  laws  of  nature  resolve  themselves 
necessarily  into  Pantheism,  or  that  of  every 
atom  of  the  universe  being  its  own  God,  and 
having  at  some  time  or  other  adopted  an 
infinite  number  of  resolutions  how  it  would 
always  behave  in  all  possible  circumstances, 
and  has  always  adliered  to  such  resolutions, 
and  always  wiU.  (See  Sir  E.  Beckett's 
Origin  of  the  Laws  of  Nature  (S.P.C.K.), 
and  the  Edinburgh  Review  of  Spencer's 
First  Principles,  January,  1884).     [G.] 

PAPA  (Uaniras,  Greek).  A  name  origi- 
nally given  to  the  bishops  of  the  Christian 
Church,  though  now  it  has  become  in  the 
West  the  pretended  prerogative  and  sole 
privilege  of  the  pope,  or  bishop  of  Rome. 
The  word  signifies  no  more  thsii.  father. 

TertuUian  (De  Pudicitia,  c.  13),  speak- 
ing indefinitely  of  any  Christian  bishop 
who  absolves  penitents,  gives  him  the  name 
oi  Benedictus  Papa.  It  has  been  asserted 
that  he  refers  especially  to  tho  bishop  of 
Eome,  but  even  if  this  were  the  case,  others 
do  not.  Heracias,  bishop  of  Alexandria, 
is  called  pope  or  papa  (Euseb.  lib.  7,  c.  7). 
St  Jerome  gires  the  title  of  Papa  to  Atha- 
nasius,  Epiphanius,  Paulinus,  and  St.  Au- 
gustine, to  whom  he  generally  inscribes 
his  epistles  Beatissimo  Papm  Augustino 
(Hieron.  Ep.  61,  ad  Pammach. :  Ep.  17, 18, 
25,  30,  ad  Aug.).  So  also  St.  Cyprian  is  ad- 
dressed as  Beatissimus  and  Oloriosissimus 
'papa  (Ep.  30,  Cler.  Rom.  ad  Cypr.,  &c.). 

The  Greek  Christians  have  continued  to 
give  the  name  Papa  to  their  priests.  And 
there  is,  in  all  Oriental  cathedrals,  and  at 
Messina  in  Sicily  (where  Oriental  customs 
are  largely  retained),  there  was  formerly  an 
ecclesiastical  dignitary  styled  Protopapa, 
who,  besides    a    urisdiistion   over    several 


PARABLE 

churches,  had  a  particular  respect  paid  him 
by  the  cathedral.  For,  upon  Whitsunday, 
the  prebendaries  went  in  procession  to  the 
Protopapa's  church  (called  the  Catholic), 
and  attended  him  to  the  cathedral,  where  he 
sang  solemn  Vespers,  according  to  the 
Greek  ritual,  and  was  afterwards  conducted 
back  to  his  own  church  with  the  same 
pompous  respect.  The  Vespers,  and  the 
Epistle  and  Gospel,  at  Pentecost,  are  still 
sung  by  Greek  priests. — Pirri,  Sicilia  Sacra. 
Diet.  Christ.  Ant,  s.  v.  Pope. 

PAPISTS  (See  Popery  ;  Romanists). 

PARABLE    (^B'D  :  napa^oXri :  parabola  : 

literally  "  a  comparison,"  from  Trapa^aXKeiv> 
to  place  side  by  side  and  so  more  generally 
an  illustration).  Defined  by  St.  Jerome, 
"  Sermonem  utilem,  sub  idonea  figurft  ex- 
pressum,  et  in  recessu  continentem  spiritu- 
alem  aliquam  admonitionem"  (in  St.  Mark 
iv.) :  many  other  ancient  definitions  are 
given  in  Suioer's  TJies.  s.  v.  irapafioXf)  ■  by 
bishop  Lowth,  "  a  continued  narrative  of  a 
fictitious  event  applied  by  way  of  simile  to 
the  illustration  of  some  important  truth." 
But  with  regard  to  this  definition,  it  must 
be  observed  that  the  event  was  not  neces- 
sarily fictitious.  Teaching  by  parable  was 
a  favourite  means  of  instruction  amongst 
the  Eastern  sages,  but  it  was  expected  to 
be  done  with  skill ;  and  nothing  was  more 
insupportable  than  to  hear  a  fool  utter 
parable:  "The  legs  of  the  lame  are  not 
equal ;  so  is  a  parable  in  the  mouth  of  fools  " 
(Prov.  xxvi.  7.).  It  is  to  be  distinguished 
from  the  fable,  the  allegoiy,  the  myth,  and 
the  proverb  (see  Trench  on  Parables,  p.  3) ; 
but  the  word  is  used  with  great  latitude  in 
the  Old  Testament.  Sometimes  it  is  applied 
to  short  proverbs  (1  Sam.  x.  12  :  xxiv.  13) ; 
sometimes  to  prophetic  utterances  (Numbers 
xxiii.-iv.) :  it  sometimes  signifies  a  mere 
discourse :  as  JoVs  parable,  which  occupies 
many  chapters  of  the  book  of  Job  (xxvi.- 
xxxi.  inclusive).  The  same  title  is  applied 
by  its  inspired  composer  to  the  seventy- 
eighth  Psalm  (ver.  2),  which  is  historical, 
not  deeply  mystical,  like  the  forty-ninth. 

It  is  generally  applied,  as  in  the  New 
Testament,  to  a  figurative  discourse,  or  a 
story  with  a  typical  meaning.  Our  Saviour 
in  the  Gospel  seldom  speaks  to  the  people 
but  in  parables :  thereby  verifying  the 
prophecy  of  Isaiah  (vi.  9),  that  the  people 
should  see  without  knowing,  and  hear  with- 
out understanding,  in  the  midst  of  instruc- 
tion. Some  parables  in  the  New  Testament 
are  supposed  to  be  true  histories.  In  others 
our  Saviour  seems  to  allude  to  some  points 
of  history  in  those  times ;  as  that  describing 
a  king  who  went  into  a  far  country  to 
receive  a  kingdom.  This  may  hint  at  the 
history  of  Archelaiis,  who,  after  the  death 


PAKABOLANI 

of  liis  father,  Herod  the  Great,  went  to 
Rome,  to  receive  from  Augustus  the  con- 
firmation of  his  fatlier's  will,  by  which  he 
had  the  kingdom  of  Judasa  left  to  him 
(Archbishop  Trench  on  Parables,  Introd.: 
Dean  Plumptre  in  Smith's  Diet,  of  Bille,  ii. 
703).  The  word  TrapajSoX^  only  occurs  twice 
in  the  New  Testament  elsewhere  than  in 
the  Gospels,  namely,  in  Hebrews  ix.  9,  and 
si.  19,  where  it  seems  to  imply  rather  a 
type  than  a  parable  in  the  usual  acceptation 
of  the  word,  and  in  both  cases  is  translated 
"  figure."    [H.] 

PARABOLANI.  In  the  ancient  Chris- 
tian Church  were  certain  ofiScers,  deputed 
to  attend  upon  the  sick,  and  to  take  care  of 
them  all  the  time  of  their  weakness.  In 
the  great  plague  at  Alexandria,  the  care  of 
the  sick  was  undertaken  by  the  brethren 
generally,  as  a  Christian  duty  (Euseb. 
S.  E.  vii.  22) ;  but  afterwards  the  order  of 
the  Parabolani  was  formed,  and  the  members 
were  incorporated  into  a  society,  to  the 
number  of  500  or  600,  elected  by  the  bishop 
of  the  place,  and  under  his  direction.  But 
that  this  was  not  an  order  peculiar  to  the 
Church  of  Alexandria  is  very  evident,  be- 
cause there  is  mention  made  of  Parabolani 
at  Bphesus  at  the  time  of  the  council  held 
there  (a.d.  449). 

They  were  probably  called  Pardbolani 
from  their  undertaking  a  most  dangerous 
and  hazardous  office  (napa^oXov  epyov),  in 
attending  the  sick,  especially  in  infectious 
and  pestilential  diseases.  The  Greeks  used 
to  call  those  TrapajSoXot,  who  hired  them- 
selves out  to  fight  with  wild  beasts  in  the 
amphitheatre ;  for  the  word  irapa^aXKfiv 
signifies  exposing  a  man's  life  to  danger 
(Socr.  H.  E.  vii.  22  :  Niceph.  H.  E.  xiv.  3). 
In  this  sense,  the  Christians  were  often 
called  Parabolani  by  the  heathens,  because 
they  were  so  ready  to  expose  their  lives  to 
martyrdom.  And,  upon  the  like  account, 
the  name  Parabolani  was  given  to  the 
officers  we  are  speaking  of.  They  were 
considered  "  clerici,"  but  of  very  subordinate 
capacity,  and  were  chosen  from  the  poorer 
classes  {Baron,  an.  416,  t.  4,  p.  401). 
They  seem  to  have  been  restless  spirits,  and 
ready  to  engage  in  any  quarrel  that  should 
happen  in  Church  or  State,  as  they  appear 
to  have  done  in  the  dispute  between  Cyril 
the  bishop  and  Orestes  the  governor  of 
Alexandria.  And  again  they  appear  as  a 
body  of  violent  partisans  at  the  "  Latro- 
cinium,"  or  "  Robber  Council,"  of  Ephesus, 
where  six  hundred  of  them  acted  as  the  tools 
of  Barsumas,  the  Eutychian,  whose  conduct 
can  only  be  designated  as  brutal  (Labbe, 
iv.  251).  Wherefore  the  emperor  Theodo- 
sius  put  them  under  the  inspection  of  the 
Prsefectus  Augustalis,'and  strictly  prohibited 
them  to  appear  at  any  public  shows,  or  in 


PAEADISE 


559 


the  common  council  of  the  city,  or  in  the 
courts  of  judicature,  unless  any  of  them  had 
a  cause  of  his  own,  or  appeared  as  syndic 
for  the  whole  body  {Cod.  Inst.  lib.  i.  tit.  3, 
de  Episc.  Leg.  18).  Which  shows  that  the 
civil  government  always  looked  upon  the 
Parabolani  as  a  formidable  body  of  men,  and 
kept  a  watchful  eye  over  them,  that  while 
they  were  serving  the  Church,  they  might 
not  do  any  disservice  to  the  State. — Diet. 
Christ.  Ant.  ii.  1551 ;  Bingham,  iii.  9. 

PARACLETE.  A  com'forter  and  advo- 
cate ;  a  title  applied  to  God  the  Holy  Ghost 
(St.  John  XV.  26).  See  Holy  Ghost,  and 
Advoeate. 

PARACLETICE  (jrapaKKryriKr)  :  fii^Xiov 
TrapaKKTlTiKov).  Among  the  Greek  Cliris- 
tians,  a  book  of  anthems,  or  hymns ;  so  called , 
because  they  chiefiy  tend  to  comfort  the 
sinner,  or  because  they  are  partly  invocatory, 
consisting  of  pious  addresses  to  God  aud 
the  saints. 

The  hymns  or  anthems  in  this  book  are 
not  appropriated  to  particular  days,  but 
contain  something  proper  .to  be  recited 
every  day,  in  the  mass,  vespers,  matins,  and 
other  offices.  The  Ferial  office  is  arranged 
not  according  to  seasons,  but  tones  (^x*")' 
which  are  eight  in  number.  These  tones 
begin  with  the  week  after  Easter  week,  and 
follow  in  regular  sequence,  spreading  there- 
fore over  eight  weeks,  when  they  begin 
again.  Each  tone  has  its  Troparia,  or  short 
hymns,  and  the  paracletice  gives  the  proper 
hymn  for  the  offices  of  the  day.  Allatius 
finds  fault  with  this  book,  alleging  that 
there  are  many  things  in  it  disrespectful  to 
the  Virgin  Mary ;  that  it  affirms  that  John 
the  Baptist,  after  his  death,  preached  Christ 
in  hell ;  and  that  Christ  Himself,  when  He 
descended  into  hell,  freed  all  mankind  from 
the  punishment  of  that  place  and  the  power 
of  the  devU  (Leo.  AUat.  de  Libris  Eecles. 
Qrxe.  p.  283). 

PARADISE  (TrapaSeio-or,  a  park;  de- 
rived from  a  Persian  word;  see  Xenophon, 
Cyr.  1 ,  3, 12).  I.  A  word  used  in  the  LXX. 
for  Garden  of  Eden,  or  DeUght  (Gen.  ii.  8, 
10 :  iii.  1-3) ;  and  employed  figuratively 
by  Jewish  writers  to  designate  the  place  of 
rest  for  the  souls  of  the  faithful  departed 
(Joseph,  xviii.  1).  As  such  the  word  is 
used  by  St.  Luke  in  relating  the  promise 
given  by  our  Blessed  Lord  to  the  penitent 
thief  on  the  Cross  (xxiii.  43).  Where  the 
paradise  is,  the  distinction  between  it  and 
Hades,  and  what  the  condition  and  know- 
ledge of  those  admitted  therein,  has  been 
the  subject  of  many  hypotheses,  which  can 
only  be  called  speculative,  as  there  is  no 
revelation  with  regard  to  it,  and  it  does  not 
come  within  our  scope.  But  reference  may 
be  made  to  TertuUian  (de  Idol.  c.  13 ;  Apol. 
c.  47),  Justin  Martyr  {Respons.  ad  Ortho- 


550 


PARAPET 


dox.),  Clement  of  Alexandria  (Frag.  sec. 
51),  St.  Jerome  (Ep.  ad.  Joh.  Uieros.),  St. 
Basil)  (Sei-m.  de  Paradiso),  and  other  early 
writers,  to  shew  that  with  the  word  was 
connected  the  idea  of  a  place  of  rest  and 
hliss  for  the  saved  souls  in  the  intermediate 
state,  there  to  remain  till  the  general  resur- 
rection (See  Bishop  Bull,  Serm.  "  On  the 
Middle  State,"  vol.  i.  p.  49 ;  Bp.  Horsley, 
Serm.  xx.;  Kouth,  B.  ii.  1,  10;  ep.  15,  55, 
66).  II.  The  porch,  or  narthex  of  a  church, 
was  sometimes  called  the  "  paradise  "  (See 
Narthex).  There  those  were  assembled,  who 
were  waiting  to  be  admitted  into  the 
number  of  the  faithful  in  full  communion. 
In  Italy,  the  word  paradise  became  softened 
paradiso;  hence  " parvise"  or  " parvis," 
the  western  porch  (See  Parvise).  In  many 
English  cathedrals  the  space  enclosed  by 
the  cloisters,  which  was  the  cathedral  bury- 
ing ground,  is  called  the  "  paradise."  Such 
burials  are  now  for  sanitary  reasons  forbidden, 
■except  with  leave  from  the  Home  Secretary. 
But  the  name  remains.     [H.] 

PARAPET.  A  low  wall  protecting"  the 
gutter  in  the  roof  of  churches  or  other 
buildings.  Early  parapets  are  universally 
plain,  but  with  the  Decorated  style  they 
begin  to  be  panelled,  and  sometimes  pierced 
with  various  patterns,  and  in  the  perpen- 
dicular they  are  very  frequently  crenel- 
lated, which  is  a  weak  and  bad  form.     [G.] 

PARAPHRASE  (CMdaic).  It  is  com- 
monly believed  that  the  first  translation  of 
the  holy  Bible  was  in  Cbaldee,  and  that 
the  ignorance  of  the  Jews  in  the  Hebrew 
tongue,  after  the  Babylonish  captivity,  was 
the  occasion  of  that  version,  called  the  Tar- 
gum,  or  Chaldee  paraphrase,  which  was 
neither  done  by  one  author,  nor  at  the  same 
time,  nor  made  upon  all  the  books  of  the  Old 
Testament.  The  first  upon  the  Pentateuch 
was  done  by  Onkelos,  a  proselyte,  who 
lived  about  the  time  of  our  Saviour,  if  we 
believe  the  Hebrew  authors ;  the  second 
upon  the  Pentateuch  is  attributed  to  Jona- 
than, the  son  of  Uzziel,  who  is  not  the  same 
with  the  Theodotion,  which  in  Greek  has 
the  same  signification  as  Jonathan  in  He- 
brew ;  that  is,  the  gift  of  God.  The  third 
upon  the  same  book  is  called  the  Targum 
Hierosolymitanum,  or  the  Jerusalem  para- 
phrase ;  the  author  of  which  is  not  certainly 
known,  nor  the  time  when  it  was  composed. 
Schikard  believes  it  to  bear  the  same  date 
as  the  Targum  of  Jerusalem,  which  was 
written  about  300  years  after  the  last  de- 
struction of  the  temple,  burnt  in  the  seven- 
tieth year  after  our  Lord's  incarnation. 
There  are,  besides  these,  three  paraphrases 
upon  the  books  of  Moses ;  another  upon  the 
Psalms,  Job,  and  Proverbs  ;  there  is  also  one 
upon  the  Canticles,  Ruth,  Lamentations, 
^cclesiastes,  and  Esther,  but  the  author  is  not 


PARDONS 

known ;  and  we  have  a  Chaldee  paraphrase 
upon  Joshua,  Judges,  Kings,  and  the  Pro- 
phets, by  Jonathan,  the  son  of  Uzziel,  who, 
according  to  the  Jews,  had  before  written 
the  paraphrase  upon  the  Pentateuch. 

Several  learned  men  believe  that  all  which 
the  rabbins  say  concerning  the  Chaldee  para- 
phrase is  fabulous,  and  that  the  oldest  of  all 
the  translations  is  that  of  the  Septuagint :  it 
is  also  added  that  they  are  later  than  St. 
Jerome,  who,  having  great  acquaintance 
with  the  most  learned  rabbins,  and  having 
written  so  much  upon  that  subject,  could 
not  fail  of  speaking  of  the  Chaldee  para- 
phrases, if  there  had  been  any  such  in  his 
time.  The  Jews  afSrm  they  were  composed 
in  the  time  of  the  prophets,  and  they  have 
them  in  so  great  veneration,  that  they  are 
obliged  to  read  in  their  synagogue  a  section 
of  Onkelos'  paraphrase,  when  they  have  read 
a  Hebrew  text  in  the  Bible. 

PARCLOSE.  Screens  separating  cha- 
pels, especially  those  at  the  east  end  of  the 
aisles,  from  the  body  of  the  church,  are 
called  parcloses. 

PARDONS  (See  Indulgences).  In  the 
Romish  Church,  pardons  or  indulgences  are 
releasement  from  the  temporary  or  purga- 
tional  punishment  of  sin ;  the  power  of  grant- 
ing which  is  supposed  to  be  lodged  in  the 
pope,  to  be  dispensed  by  him  to  the  bishops 
and  inferior  clergy,  for  the  benefit  of  peni- 
tents throughout  the  Church.  In  the  theorj- 
of  pardons,  the  point  is  assumed,  that  holy 
men  may  accomplish  more  than  is  strictly 
required  of  them  by  the  Divine  law ;  that 
there  is  a  meritorious  value  in  this  over- 
plus; that  such  value  is  transferable,  and 
that  it  is  deposited  in  the  spiritual  treasury 
of  the  Church,  subject  to  the  disposal  of 
the  pope,  to  be,  on  certain  conditions,  ap- 
plied to  the  benefit  of  those  whose  defi- 
ciencies stand  in  need  of  such  a  compensa- 
tion. A  distinction  is  then  drawn  between 
the  temporary  and  the  eternal  punishment 
of  sin ;  the  former  of  which  not  only  em- 
braces penances,  and  all  satisfactions  for 
sin  in  the  present  life,  but  also  the  pains  of 
purgatory  in  the  next.  These  are  supposed 
to  be  within  the  control  and  jurisdiction  of 
the  Chtu-ch  ;  and  in  the  case  of  any  in- 
dividual may  be  ameliorated  or  terminated 
by  the  imputation  of  so  much  of  the  over- 
abundant merits  of  the  saints,  &c.,  as  may 
be  necessary  to  balance  the  deficiencies  of 
the  sufferer. 

The  privilege  of  selling  pardons,  was  fre- 
quently granted  by  the  pope  to  monastic 
bodies  in  every  part  of  the  Church;  and 
the  scandals  and  disorders  consequent  upon 
this,  was  one  of  the  first  moving  causes  of 
the  Reformation.  Against  these  pernicious 
errors,  the  Church  of  England  protests  in  her 
twenty-second  Article  :  "  The  Romish  doc- 


PARISH 

trine  concerning  p\iTga,tovy,2}ardon s,  worsh i p- 
ping,  and  adorstiou,  as  well  of  images  as  of 
relics,  and  also  of  invocation  of  saints,  is  a 
fond  thing,  vainly  invented,  and  grounded 
upon  no  warranty  of  Scripture,  but  rather 
repugnant  to  the  word  of  God." 

It  is  not  necessary  to  quote  the  words 
of  Bellarmine,  Johannes  de  Turrecremata, 
Koffensis,  Laymanus,  Gregorius  de  Valentia, 
and  other  Roman  ritualists,  on  this  subject ; 
the  _  idea  running  throughout  being  that 
Christ  and  His  Saints  have  accumulated  so 
vast  a  treasure  of  good  works,  ihat  it  may  be 
used  for  the  benefit  of  others  at  the  discre- 
tion of  the  iKjpe. 

Thus  Leo  X.,  in  his  decretal,  ann.  1518, 
says,  "  The  pope  of  Home  may,  for  reasonable 
causes,  grant  to  the  same  saints  of  Christ  who, 
charity  uniting  them,  are  members  of  Christ, 
whether  they  be  in  this  life  or  in  purga- 
toiy,  pardons  out  of  the  superabuudancy  of 
the  merits  of  Christ  and  the  saints  ;  and 
that  be  used,  for  the  living  as  well  as 
for  the  dead,  by  his  apostolic  power  of  grant- 
ing pardons,  to  dispense  or  distribute  the 
treasure  of  the  merits  of  Christ  and  the 
saints,  to  confer  the  indulgence  itself,  after 
the  manner  of  an  absolution,  or  transfer  it 
after  the  manner  of  a  suffrage."  So  that,  as 
Durandus  says,  "  The  Church  can  communi- 
cate from  this  treasure  to  any  one,  or  several, 
for  their  sins,  in  part  or  in  whole,  according 
as  it  pleases  the  Church  to  communicate 
more  or  less  from  the  treasure."  It  is 
almost  needless  to  add  that  the  theory 
finds  no  support  in  the  writings  of  the  early 
Fathers. 

PARISH.  A  parish  is  that  circuit  of 
gi'ound  which  is  committed  to  the  charge 
of  one  parson  or  vicar,  or  other  minister 
having  cure  of  souls  therein.  A  reputed 
parish  is  where  there  is  a  parochial  chapel, 
with  all  parochial  rites  entirely  independ- 
ent of  the  mother-church,  as  to  sacraments, 
marriages,  burials,  repairs,  &c.  (See  Cha- 
peV). 

The  word  parish  is  from  the  Greek  word 
TrapotKialQjaroife'a),  which  signifies  sojourn- 
ing, or  living  as  a  stranger  or  settler  as  dis- 
tinguished from  a  native ;  for  so  it  is  used 
among  the  classical  Greek  writers.  The 
Septuagint  translate  the  Hebrew  word  ^J 
(Ger"), peregrinus,  by  irapoiKos  (Gen.  xv.  13, 
&c.),  and  the  word  ")1JI2  (Magor},  peregrin- 
atio,  by  ■n-apoiKia  (Ps.  cxix.  54). 

The  primitive  Christians  received  a  great 
part  of  their  customs,  and  also  their  phrase- 
ology from  the  Jews;  who,  when  they 
travelled  abroad,  and  many  of  them  were 
settled  in  any  town,  either  built  them  a 
synagogue,  or  else  procured  a  large  room, 
where  they  performed  their  public  worship ; 
and  all  that  were  strangers  in  that  place 
met  there  at  the  times  of  public  devotion. 


PARISH 


561 


This  brotheriiood  of  Jews,  which  was  mixed 
with  the  inhabitants  of  the  place,  they  called 
the  iTapoiKia,  or  the  society  of  the  sojourn- 
ers. At  the  beginning  of  Christianity,  the 
Christians  were  in  the  same  condition  with 
the  Jews,  they  being  themselves  either 
Jews,  or  Jewish  proselytes,  or  liviu<T  in  a 
retired  condition,  sequestered  from  the 
world,  and  little  mixing  with  affairs.  Upon 
which  account  St.  Peter  addresses  them 
i>s  napoiKovs,  &c.,  as  strangers  and  pilgrims 
(1  St.  Pet.  ii.  11).  This  number  of  strangers 
in  the  heatlien  cities  was  called  the  napoiKia, 
over  which  there  was  set,  by  aiwstolical 
authority,  a  bishop,  a  npofaras,  a  cazan 
(an  inspector),  or  a  rhosh  cohel  (a  head  of 
the  congregation) ;  all  which  names  denoted 
the  episcopal  authority,  and  which  in  Uttle 
time  centred  in  the  one  most  usual  name, 
of  fwla-Konos,  or  bishop,  as  is  plainly  seen  by 
the  Ignalian  epistles.  So  that  the  inlo-Konos 
and  napoiKia  became  relative  terms ;  he  that 
had  the  superintendency  of  the  congrega- 
tion, whether  one  or  more,  was  called  the 
bishop,  and  the  congregation  under  his 
care  was  called  the  Trapoixia.  Hence,  in  the 
most  early  time  of  the  Greek  Church,  the 
word  irapoiKla  was  used  to  signify,  what  we 
now  call  a  diocese ;  and  thus,  in  the  aposto- 
lic canons,  a  bishop  that  leaves  his  diocese 
(napoiKiav)  for  another  is  to  be  reduced  to 
lay-communion.  Hence  it  is  said,  "Tlie 
bishop  of  the  diocese  (napoiKias)  of 
Alexandria  departed  this  life."  And  again, 
"the  glory  of  the  diocese  (jrapoi/ci'ar)  of 
CMsarea."  The  Latins  took  up  the  same 
way  of  expression,  from  the  Greek,  denoting 
a  diocese  b}'  the  vfori  parochia,  which  mode 
of  expression  lasted  till  after  the  time  of 
Charles  the  Great. 

But  it  is  to  be  ob.«er\'ed,  that  when  the 
word  parochia  signified  a  diocese,  the  word 
diocesis  signified  a  parish.  So  in  the 
Council  of  Agatha,  presbyter  dum  diocesin 
tenet,  "  whilst  the  presbyter  is  in  possession 
of  his  living."  And  in  the  third  Council  of 
Orioans,  diocesis  is  the  same  with  lasilica, 
a  parish  church.  But  in  the  seventh  or 
eighth  century,  when  parish  churches  began 
frequently  to  be  founded  in  villages,  the  old 
names  shifted,  and  diocesis  was  used  to 
denote  the  extent  of  the  bishopi's  jurisdic- 
tion ;  and  parochia,  the  place  where  the 
presbyter's  care  was  limited. 

That  the  word  irapoiKia  was  not  exclusively 
applied  to  a  parish,  and  that  a  bishop's 
diocese  was  not  anciently  confined  to  a 
single  parish,  as  it  has  been  asserted  by  the 
advocates  for  Presbyterianism,  see  Maurice's 
"  Defence  of  Diocesan  lipiscopacy,"  and 
Scater's  "  Original  Draught  of  the  Primitive 
Church."  See  also  Suicer,  Thes. ;  s.  v. 
TrapoiKta. 

Many  parish  churches  were  founded  in 

2  0 


562 


PAEISH 


great  towns  and  villages  in  Italy,  Spain, 
and  Gaul  during  the  fourtli,  fifth,  and  sixth 
centuries  under  the  cathedral  church  of  the 
bishop.  The  time  when  parishes  were 
fonned  in  England  cannot  be  fixed  with 
certainty.  The  diocese  existed  before  the 
parish,  and  originally  the  bishops  sent  out 
their  clergy  (who  lived  with  them)  to  preach 
in  different  parts  of  the  diocese  as  occasion 
required ;  but  as  the  number  of  converts 
increased  this  method  became  inadequate, 
and  a  resident  clergy  was  found  expedient 
to  serve  the  churches  which  had  been  built 
and  endowed  by  lords  of  manors,  and  other 
o^vners  of  property.  Thus  parishes  were 
formed.  As  the  diocese  was  commonly 
coextensive  with  one  or  more  kingdoms,  or 
tribal  divisions,  so  a  parish  was  generally 
conterminous  with  a  manor,  a  township,  or 
group  of  townships  (see  Stubbs'  Constit. 
Hist.  i.  ch.  viii.).  And  this  accounts  for 
the  great  variation  in  the  extent  and  shape  of 
different  parishes.  There  was  at  first  no 
appropriation  of  ecclesiastical  dues  to  any 
particular  church ;  but  every  man  was  at 
liberty  to  contribute  his  tithes  to  whatever 
priest  or  church  he  pleased,  provided  only 
that  he  paid  them  to  some ;  or  if  he  made  no 
special  appointment  or  appropriation,  they 
were  handed  over  to  the  bishop  for  distribu- 
tion among  the  clergy,  the  poor,  and  for  other 
pious  purposes.  The  traditional  founder  of 
parishes  in  England  is  Archbishop  Theodore, 
A.D.  669,  but  it  is  certain  that  they  existed 
before  his  time,  although  he  probably  de- 
veloped and  organized  the  system  (See 
Parochial  System).      [W.  B.  W.  S.] 

In  1520,  according  to  a  book  made  out 
by  Cardinal  Wolsey,  the  number  of  parish 
churches  is  reckoned  9407,  but  Chamberlain 
makes  them  9913.  Camden  reckons  9284. 
The  number  of  charity  briefs  issued  was 
according  to  an  account  in  Burn's  "  Eccle- 
siastical Law,"  10,489  (See  Briefs).  Arch- 
deacon Plymley,  in  bis  charge  to  the  clergy 
of  Salop,  1793,  says  that,  from  the  "  Liber 
Begis,"  there  were  in  England  and  Wales 
5098  rectories,  3687  vicarages,  and  2970 
churches,  neither  rectorial  nor  vicarial;  in 
all  11,755  churches  in  the  10,000  parishes. 
It  is  scarcely  necessary  to  add,  that  both 
churches  and  parishes  have  much  increased 
since  that  period. 

[Although  parishes  were  altered  in  old 
times  by  royal  authority,  it  has  long  been 
the  law  that  it  requires  either  a  general 
or  special  Act  of  Parliament.  Accordingly 
many  special  Acts  were  passed,  among  which 
may  be  noticed  the  singular  one  of  Anne, 
carving  the  rectory  of  St.  James  out  of 
the  vicarage  of  St.  Martin-in-the-Fields. 
General  Acts  for  the  purpose  of  dividing 
and  consolidating  parishes  by  commissioners, 
who  are  all  now  merged  in  the  Ecclesiastical 


PAEOCHIAL  SYSTEM 

Commissioners,  began  with  58  G.  IIL  c.  45, 
followed  by  c.  134  of  the  next  year,  and  3  &  4 
Vic.  c.  60, 6  &  7,  Vic.  c.  37  (caUed  Peel's  Act), 
19  &  20  Vict.  c.  104  (Lord  Blandford's  Act), 
under  which  every  ecclesiastical  district  be- 
comes a  new  parish  as  soon  as  the  inciimbent 
of  the  church  becomes  entitled  to  the  '  sur- 
plice fees'  on  his  own  account,  and  thereupon 
the  inhabitants  lose  all  ecclesiastical  rights 
in  the  old  parish.  Fuller  v.  Alford  (Q.B.  D. 
418).  The  Acts  of  this  kind  have  become  so 
numerous  and  complicated  that  it  is  im- 
possible to  explain  them  here ;  and  unneces- 
sary, as  no  action  can  be  taken  under  them 
without  the  consent  of  the  Ecclesiastical 
Commissioners  confirmed  by  the  Privy 
Council.  It  must  be  borne  in  mind  too, 
that  they  do  not  affect  any  civil  rights,  or 
the  election  of  churchwardens,  from  which 
result  some  yet  unsettled  legal  questions 
as  to  parochial  civil  matters  and  the  powers 
and  duties  of  churchwardens  as  overseers  of 
the  poor  when  they  are  so.]     [G.] 

PABLIAMENT,  PBAYEB  FOE.  This 
was  probably  composed  by  Laud  when  be 
was  bishop  of  St  David's.  It  appears  first  in 
"  A  forme  of  Common  Prayer  ....  to  be  read 
every  Wednesday  during  the  present  visita- 
tion. Set  forth  by  his  Majestie's  Authority. 
Beprinted  at  London  by  Bonham  Morton, 
and  John  Bill,  Printers  to  the  King's  most 
excellent  Majestie.  Anno  1625."  It  also 
appears  in  at  least  two  forms  of  Prayer, 
which  were  issued  by  Laud,  after  he  became 
archbishop  of  Canterbury,  and  during  the 
rule  of  the  "  Long  Parliament."  It  was  in- 
serted Ln  a  Past-day  Service  for  the  12th  of 
June,  1661,  and  afterwards  in  its  present 
place.  The  word  "  dominions  "  was  substi- 
tuted for  "  kingdoms  "  by  an  Order  of  Coun- 
cil of  January  1, 1801,  probably  because  the 
former  being  a  more  comprehensive  word,  it 
would  embrace  the  colonies,  and  be  more 
suitable  than  "  kingdoms  "  to  an  empire  so 
extended,  and  of  so  mixed  a  character  as 
that  of  the  English  sovereigns. — Blunt's 
P.  B.  i.  64.     [H.] 

PAEOCHIAL  SYSTEM,  THE.  The 
"  Parochial  System  "  is  a  subject  of  so  much 
importance,  that  it  seems  to  justify  a 
careful  inquiry  into  its  origin  and  meaning, 
as  it  has  hitherto  been  understood  in  Eng- 
land, in  order  that  we  may  know  what  we 
should  lose,  if  unhappily  it  should  ever 
cease  to  exist  in  this  country.  For  the 
earlier  use  of  the  word,  see  Parish. 

The  idea  of  a  "  parish,"  in  the  later  use 
of  the  word,  grew  out  of  the  organization  of 
the  Eoman  Empire.  Sometimes  the  district 
surrounding  a  great  city  wa;s  governed  by 
the  magistrates  of  that  city;  and  sometimes 
independent  communities,  having  their  own 
rulers  and  their  own  territories,  were  formed 
in  rural  districts.    Here,  then,  was  a  fore- 


PAKOCHIAL  SYSTEM 

sliadowiog  of  the  mode  of  goverument  of 
the  Christian  Church.  And  so  it  came  to 
pass  that  as  Christianity  advanced  and  pre- 
vailed in  the  world,  the  Ecclesiastical 
divisions  followed  the  Civil  divisions  of  the 
Roman  Empire. 

In  this  country,  as  elsewhere,  the  Church 
was  at  first  a  mere  collection  of  missions, 
unconnected  and  independent.  Separate 
parishes  grew  up  slowly ;  and  they  were 
not  infrequently  created  in  this  manner ; 
namely,  that  the  landed  proprietor  in  any 
district  having  himself  embraced  Christi- 
anity, would  huUd  a  church  and  endow  it, 
perhaps  with  a  grant  of  land,  perhaps  with 
the  tithes  of  his  estate.  In  this  latter  case, 
the  estate  and  the  parish  would  be  co- 
extensive, the  lord  of  the  manor  becoming 
the  patron  of  the  church  built  upon  his 
manor.  This  often  explains  the  variety  in 
the  sizes  of  different  parishes,  and  the  fact 
of  portions  of  parishes  being  sometimes  in- 
•cluded  in  other  parishes. 

In  the  seventh  century,  the  century  in 
which  there  flourished  Pauhnus  and  Aidan, 
and  Wilfrid  and  Chad,  and  Theodore  and 
Cuthbert,  the  parochial  system  received  a 
great  impulse.  Christianity  gradually  as- 
sumed a  more  settled  character  in  this 
island.  It  began  to  lay  hold  of  the  Saxon 
race.  The  mission  of  Augustine  had  been 
fruitful  amongst  the  Jutes  of  Kent,  and  that 
of  Birinus  in  Wessex;  and  now  the  mis- 
sionaries from  the  North  added  great 
strength  to  the  cause.  Chad's  labours  seem 
to  have  been  purely  missionary,  although  he 
must  have  had,  besides  his  little  establish- 
ment at  Lichfield,  oratories  and  smaller 
mission  churches  in  the  districts  which 
he  visited.  But  Christianity  was  gaining 
ground  everywhere.  Paulinus  builds  a 
■church  at  Lincoln,  having  first  converted 
the  governor  of  that  city  and  his  whole 
family  to  the  faith  of  Christ.  Bede  tells  us 
that  he  built  this  church  of  stone  and  of 
beautiful  workmanship.  "  Ecclesiam  operis 
«gregii  de  lapide  fecit."  The  church  soon 
fell,  probably  through  violence,  in  those 
troublous  times ;  but  portions  of  it  were  still 
standing  in  Bede's  time.  Oswald  becomes 
king  of  Northumbria  a.d.  634;  and  he 
.applies  to  the  Scottish  Church  for  a  bishop 
who  might  spread  the  Christian  faith  among 
the  English  people ;  and  they  sent  him  the 
eminent  and  saintly  Aidan,  who  received 
:as  his  see  the  island  of  Lindisfarn.  The 
bishop  preached  the  gospel  to  the  people  in 
his  own  tongue  ;  and  King  Oswald  inter- 
preted his  words  to  them.  So  Christianity 
«pread.  "  Churches  were  built,"  says  Bede, 
"  in  several  places ;  and  money  and  lands 
were  given  to  build  monasteries."  Bede 
mentions  incidentally,  as  examples  of  the 
gradual  growth    and    development  of  the 


PAKOCHIAL  SYSTEM 


.503 


Church,  the  fact  that  John,  bishop  of  York, 
was  invited  by  a  Saxon  earl  named  Puch 
to  consecrate  a  church  which  he  had  built 
for  his  dependents;  and  presently  afterwards 
we  find  this  same  bishop  consecratino- 
another  church  built  on  another  estate  by 
its  owner.  Earl  Addi.  Thus  the  parochial 
system  grew  and  was  strengthened.  It 
received  no  doubt  a  powerful  impulse  under 
the  energetic  rule  of  Archbishop  Theodore, 
A.D.  669.  He  has,  indeed,  been  regarded  as 
the  traditional  founder  of  the  "  parochial 
system"  in  this  country ;  but  it  would  be 
more  correct  to  say  that  he  developed  and 
extended  what  was  already  in  the  germ. 
His  comprehensive  idea  was  that  of  the 
"  pastoral  system,"  worked  by  an  educated 
and  devoted  body  of  clergy,  thoroughly 
supervised  by  a  sufficient  number  of  bishops, 
with  sees  of  manageable  dimensions ;  and 
the  whole  regulated  by  an  annual  Synod. 
And  it  is  to  him  above  others  that  we  are 
indebted  for  having  cai-ried  out  this  idea. 
Bishops  were  planted  everywhere,  with 
parochial  clergy  under  them,  and  endow- 
ments provided  for  their  support. 

Of  these  endowments  we  find  "  tithes  " 
mentioned  at  an  early  period  in  the  history 
of  our  Church.  It  is  said  that  Augustine 
recommended  them  on  his  arrival  at  the 
close  of  the  sixth  century.  At  all  events, 
they  became  an  important  element  of 
strength  to  the  "  parochial  system  "  by  the 
end  of  the  seventh  century.  If  it  be  asked 
why  "  tithes "  were  not  at  once  generally 
adopted  in  the  Christian  Church  for  the 
support  of  the  priesthood,  it  should  be  re- 
membered that,  as  long  as  Judaism  lasted, 
tithes  were  paid  to  the  Jewish  priests  and 
Levites,  by  Divine  ajopointment ;  and  so, 
during  the  interval  between  the  passing 
away  of  Judaism  and  the  establishment  of 
Christianity,  extraordinary  and  exceptional 
means,  such  as  "  community  of  goods," 
were  adopted  for  the  maintenance  of  the 
clergy  and  the  poor  of  the  infant  Christian 
Church.  To  this  it  must  be  added  that  the 
general  institution  of  tithes  would  imply 
the  adoption  of  Christianity  by  a  whole 
state  or  kingdom,  as  well  as  the  protection 
of  the  Church  by  the  civil  power.  This 
explains  why  in  the  first  dawn  of  Christi- 
anity we  find  no  evidence,  of  the  general 
adoption  of  tithes  as  an  endowment  for  the 
Church. 

On  the  other  hand,  there  is  no  evidence 
of  any  Divine  direction  that  "  tithes  "  were 
to  cease  under  the  Christian  covenant.  On 
the  contrary,  they  are  frequently  mentioned 
with  approval  as  embodying  a  great  princi- 
ple, and  recommending  a  great  duty,  name- 
ly, that  of  consecrating  a  liberal  portion  of 
our  substance  to  God  and  His  service.  Ori- 
gen  in  the  third  century  mentions  tithes  as 

2  o  2 


564 


PAEOCHIAL  SYSTEM 


"  a  portion  of  our  income  dedicated  to  God, 
■which  ouglit  to  be  exceeded  by  Christians." 
The  Apostolical  Constitutions  in  the  fourth 
century  refer  to  tithes,  as  given  "  in  accord- 
ance with  the  command  of  God  ; "  and  St. 
Jerome  speaks  of  tithes  as  a  part  of "  the 
rudimentary  teaching  of  the  Jews ;  "  and  as 
indicating  "  the  least  that  Christians  ought 
to  give,  in  proportion  to  their  means."  St. 
Augustine  also  warns  those  who  till  the 
earth  "not  to  defraud  the  Church  in  the 
matter  of  tithes." 

It  will  be  seen  from  what  has  already 
been  stated,  that  "  tithes  "  in  this  country 
are,  in  their  origin  and  purpose,  freewill 
offerings,  the  voluntary  contributions  of 
their  original  owners  to  the  service  of  God ; 
not  national  property,  in  the  sense  in  which 
some  would  regard  them ;  but  property 
dedicated  for  ever  by  Christian  proprietors 
for  sacred  purposes.  They  existed  long 
before  Acts  of  Parliament,  although  they 
are  now  protected  and  regulated  by  Statute 
Law.  Tithes  were  legalized  in  Mercia  after 
the  synod  of  Cechyth  in  a.d.  787  (see 
Haddon  and  Slubbs,  Cone.  iii.  636),  and 
Isecame  general  throughout  England.  Thus, 
for  more  than  1,000  years,  the  payment  of 
tithes,  originally  instituted  by  God  Himself, 
and  of  which  St.  Jerome  says,  that  it  was  to 
be  understood  to  continue  in  its  fuU  force 
in  the  Christian  Church,  has  been  recognised 
by  the  laws  of  the  Church  and  Realm  of 
England,  as  of  moral  and  perpetual  obliga- 
tion (See  Tithes). 

Now  the  tithe  of  land  for  the  support  of 
Christ's  ministers  throughout  a  whole  com- 
munity or  kingdom  implies  the  acceptance 
of  Christianity  by  that  whole  community. 
And  it  is  here  that  we  recognise  the  value 
of  the  union  of  Church  and  State  in  a  well- 
ordered  Christian  commonwealth.  We  also 
see  how  closely  what  we  call  the  "  parochial 
system "  is  bound  up  with  our  institutions 
in  Church  and  State.  For  thus  the  whole 
country  is  mapped  out  into  parishes,  each  pa- 
rish having  its  own  recognised  spiritual  in- 
structor, whose  income  in  the  great  majority 
of  cases,  especially  those  of  the  more  ancient 
endowments,  comes  directly  out  of  the  pro- 
duce of  the  land.  The  endowments  of  the 
Church  are  therefore  not  the  property  of  the 
State,  as  some  suppose,  but  the  produce  of 
the  free  gifts  of  former  ages  to  God  and  His 
Church,  those  gifts  being  now  regulated  and 
protected  by  the  Law.  Thus,  in  theory  at 
least,  every  inhabitant  of  this  country  has 
a  spiritual  pastor  provided  for  him,  at  whose 
hands  he  may  claim  the  ministrations  of 
religion.  In  thousands  of  parishes  through- 
out the  land  the  hmuanising,  civilising 
effects  of  this  system  are  manifest  in  the 
presence  of  men  of  culture  and  refinement 
(sometimes  the  only  men  of  education  near 


PAKSOX 

at  hand),  who  by  their  high  character  and 
Christian  example  save  many  a  district  from 
lapsing  into  paganism.  But  the  vast  in- 
crease and  irregular  distribution  of  our 
population  have  in  many  districts  almost 
swamped  the  "parochial  system ; "  and  one 
of  the  most  important  social  and  moral 
problems  of  the  day  is  how  to  meet  these 
difficulties,  and  by  a  wise  extension  of  the 
parochial  system,  in  itself  so  excellent,  to 
make  it  once  more  coextensive  with  our 
needs  and  requirements.  Experience  has 
taught  us  that  our  large  and  overgrown 
parishes  are  often  best  administered,  at 
least  for  a  time,  by  a  staff  of  clergy  working 
from  one  centre  and  under  one  head,  until 
circrunstances  point  out  when  and  where 
new  and  independent  districts  may  best  be 
formed.  Meanwhile  mission-rooms  and 
school-rooms,  and  mission-chapels  and 
chapels  of  ease,  will  be  ri.sing  up,  and  the 
help  of  earnest  and  devout  Christian  laymen 
will  be  gladly  welcomed  for  visiting  the 
people,  and  addressing  them,  and  conducting 
services  for  them,  under  the  direction  of  the 
incumbent,  in  unconsecrated  buildings. 

The  advantages  of  the  parochial  system 
cannot  easily  be  overrated.  It  places  the 
parish  priest  in  charge,  not  merely  of  a 
congregation,  but  of  a  territorial  district, 
with  all  its  inhabitants— all  those  at  least 
who  choose  to  accept  his  ministrations — so 
that,  in  theory,  there  is  not  a  single  indi- 
vidual who  has  not  a  claim  to  the  spiritual 
help  of  some  duly  authorised  clergyman. 

The  constant  and  systematic  visitation  of 
the  people  by  their  clergyman  is  implied  in 
the  "  parochial  system."  And  since  it  is 
no  part  of  the  system  of  our  reformed 
branch  of  the  Church  Catholic  that  her 
members  should  come  periodically  to  their 
pastor  for  private  confession  and  absolu- 
tion, there  is  all  the  more  reason  why  he 
should  visit  them  as  their  friend  and 
spiritual  adviser,  as  to  the  things  which 
concern  their  salvation.  Such  is  the  advan- 
tage of  the  "parochial  system,"  rightly 
administered.     [E.  B.] 

PAROCHIAL  MISSIONS.  Great  success 
has  attended  this  method  of  furthering  paro- 
chial work.  The  Parochial  Mission  Societj'- 
alone  have  held  upwards  of  1,500  missions, 
and  in  many  dioceses  Societies  -of  "  Mission 
Preachers  "  have  been  formed  for  this  work. 

PARSON  (Persona  ecclesiie).  One  that 
has  full  possession  of  all  the  rectorial  rights 
of  a  parochial  church.  He  is  called  parson, 
psrsona,  because  by  his  person  the  Church, 
which  is  an  invisible  body,  is  in  his  parish 
represented.  He  sustains  in  the  eye  of  the 
law  the  person  of  the  Church,  in  any  action 
touching  the  same.  There  are  four  requisites 
as  necessarj'  to  becoming  a  parson.  (1) 
Holy  Orders;    (2)  Presentation;    (3)  Insti- 


PAKSONAGE 

tution;  (4)  Induction  (q.v.).  After  these 
ceremonies  the  clerk  becomes  "  parson 
iraparsoiiee,''  or  "  persona  inii>ersonata " ; 
and  "  he  has  then  only  to  read  himself  in  " ; 
that  is,  to  say  divine  service  and  read  the 
;^9  articles,  and  publicly  declare  his  assent 
'.o  the  same.  The  freehold  of  the  parsonage- 
house,  glebe,  and  church  is  in  the  parson, 
except  in  the  case  of  a  lay  rector,  who  holds 
the  freehold  of  the  chancel.  The  tiihes  and 
dues  are  payable  to  him.  The  repairs  of  the 
church  and  churchyard  fall  upon  the  parish- 
ioners ;  those  of  the  chancel  on  the  parson, 
unless  there  is  a  lay  rector,  who  is  liable 
for  the  repair  of  the  chancel,  but  is  not  a 
"  persona."  A  vicar  is  not,  properly  speak- 
ing, parson,  though  often  popularly  called  so. 

The  word  persona  is,  however,  applied  in 
ancient  documents  to  others  besides  paro- 
chial incumbents,  that  is  to  ecclesiastical 
officers  who  had  a  personal  responsibility  for 
the  services  and  duties  proper  to  their 
churches  (See  Persona). — Stephen's  Black- 
ttone,  vol.  iii.  p.  19  seq.     [H.] 

PARSONAGE.  The  parson's  residence. 
It  is  applied  both  to  rectories  and  to  vicar- 
ages, and  indeed  to  the  official  residences 
of  all  incumbents  of  parishes,  parochial 
districts,  or  chapelries.  The  power  to  give 
and  to  devise  land  for  parsonages  has  been 
dealt  with  by  the  legislature  in  the  same 
gradual  and  inconclusive  way  as  church 
building.  The  only  obstacle  to  unlimited 
giving  of  land  for  such  purposes  bj'  persons 
seised  in  fee  was  the  Mortmain  Act,  which 
required  troublesome  formalities.  43  G. 
111.  c.  108  authorised  gifts  or  devises  of 
land  up  to  five  acres  for  both  chmxhes  and 
2)arsonages,  but  only  by  absolute  owners, 
ol  G.  111.  and  58  G.  ill.  enabled  tenants  for 
life  to  sell  for  those  purposes,  but  the  money 
had  to  be  resettled  with  the  estate.  But  by 
28  &  29  Vic.  c.  69  (1865)  tenants  for  life  may 
give  an  acre  for  a  parsonage  (but  not  a 
church!)  without  resettling  the  value. 
Then  by  36  &  37  Vic.  c.  50,  sites  for  any 
place  of  worship  and  residences  up  to  one 
acre  may  be  given  by  a  tenant  for  life  and 
the  next  heir  or  his  guardian,  even  if  the 
tenant  for  life  himself  as  has  been  decided ; 
which  is  extended  to  corporations  by  45  Vic. 
c.  21 :  which  looks  as  if  the  Act  of  1865 
was  forgotten  by  the  drawer  of  that  of  1875 ; 
or  else  it  is  difficult  to  guess  why  the  1865 
Act  was  not  simply  extended  to  churches, 
or  why  either  of  them  need  limit  the  gift  of 
a  jiarsonage  and  its  appurtenances  to  one 
acre,  if  it  may  be  given  at  all  by  a  tenant  for 
life.  But  simplicity  seems  unattainable  in 
all  kinds  of  ecclesiastical  legislation  now.  [G.] 

PAR  VISE.  A  chamber  over  a  church 
porch,  as  at  Drontheim,  Paisley,  Christ 
Church  (Hants),  Hereford,  &c.  The  parvise 
was  most  likely  always  a  kind  of  domus 


PASCHAL  EPISTLES 


565 


iiidusa  for  some  officer  of  the  church,  as 
for  instance,  the  sacristan;  and  from  the 
frequent  occurrence  of  an  altar  in  the  east 
window,  we  may  presume  that  it  was  some- 
times a  temporary  lodging  for  a  priest. 
The  word  is  used  in  France  to  signify  also 
the  open  space  round  cathedrals  or  other 
churches ;  like  paradise,  of  which  parvise 
is  probably  a  contraction  (See  Paradise). 

PASCH  (nda-xa)  :  the  festival  of  Easter. 
The  name  is  derived  from  the  Aramaic 
form  of  the  Hebrew  for  Passover  (nD|); 
and  was  retained  in  the  Latin.  Though 
in  the  Church  of  England  the  name  Easter 
has  entirely  superseded  the  "pasch"  (see 
Easter),  the  latter  was  once  familiar,  and  is 
still  to  be  found  in  the  "  paste  eggs "'  (pasch, 
or  pasque),  which  in  the  north  of  England 
are  at  Easter  presented  to  children  or  friends. 
Eggs  were  considered  symbolical  of  the 
resurrection,  as  may  be  gathered  from  the 
prayer  in  the  form  of  benediction  of  eggs 
made  for  the  use  of  England,  Ireland,  and 
Scotland,  by  Pope  Paul  V.  These  eggs  are 
hard-boiled,  and  gilt,  or  tinged  with  colour. 
"  Ovum  pasohale,  croceum  seu  luteum " 
(Cole's  Lat.  Diet.).  The  custom  of  giving 
and  receiving  pasch  eggs  is  very  widely 
observed  in  Russia  (brand's  Antiq.  App. 
yiO).     [fl.] 

PASCHAL.  Pertaining  to  the  Passover. 
The  lamb  offered  in  this  Jewish  festival 
being  a  prominent  type  of  Christ,  the 
terms  pasehal  and  paschal  lamb  are  often 
used  m  application  to  the  Redeemer.  An 
example  occurs  in  the  proper  preface  for 
Easter  Day,  in  the  Communion  Office,  thus : 
"Thy  Son  Jesus  Christ  our  Lord,  for  he 
is  the  very  Paschal  Lamb,  which  was  offered 
for  us,  and  hath  taken  away  the  sin  of  the 
world,"  &c. 

PASCHAL  EPISTLES,  and  PASCHAL 
CONTROVERSY.  1.  The  former  were 
letters  written  by  patriarchs  and  metro- 
poUtans  to  their  suffragan  bishops  to  give 
notice  to  them  of  the  time  of  keeping  Easter, 
as  that  time  varied.  St.  Ambrose  thus 
sent  instructions  to  his  province  of  Milan 
{Ep.  83,  od  Episc.per  Mylian),  and  in  various 
councils  the  metropolitans  were  enjoined  to 
take  heed  to  the  matter  {Cone.  Carth.  3; 
can.  1  &  11 ;  Cone.  Bracar.  2,  can.  9 ;  Cone. 
Tolet.  4,  can.  5).  Leo  says  that  the  care 
of  making  the  calculation  for  the  Pasch  (or 
Easter)  was  committed,  at  the  Council  of 
Nicaja,  especially  to  the  bishop  of  Alexandria 
(Leo,  Ep.  72,  al.  70,  ad  Mareian.  Imper.). 
Tliis,  however,  was  probably  because  the 
school  of  Alexandria  was  well  known  for 
its  superiority  in  mathematical  science,  and 
not  that  the  bishop  of  Alexandria  as  such, 
had  any  authority  over  other  churches  {Diet. 
Christ.  Ant.  ii.  1562).  It  was  the  custom  on 
the  Feast  of  the  Epiphany  to  announce  the 


J)66 


PASSALOEYNCHITES 


exact  day  of  the  month  on  which  the  Pasch 
or  Easter  should  be  held.  II.  Into  the 
controversies  which  took  place  as  to  the  day 
on  which  the  Easter  festival  should  take 
place,  it  is  impossible  to  enter  here ;  they 
are  detailed  in  the  "  Dictionary  of  Christian 
Antiquities  "  (i.  592 ;  see  also  Easter ;  and 
Qvartodecimans).  The  quartodeciman  or 
Jewish  method,  which  was  advocated  by 
Polycarp,  aimed  at  its  observance  on  the 
actual  anniversary  of  the  resurrection  of  our 
Lord — the  third  day  after  the  14th  day  of  the 
month  Nisan.  Anicetus,  on  the  other  hand, 
held  that  it  should  always  be  observed  on 
the  Lord's  day.  This  difference  was  settled 
by  mutual  toleration ;  but  the  question 
remained  open  till  the  Council  of  Avles  (A.n. 
314)  and  the  Council  of  Nicaaa  (a.d.  325), 
when  it  was  ruled  that  it  should  be  a  Lord's 
day.  It  is  a  mistake  to  suj)pose  that  the 
Britons,  as  is  sometimes  asserted,  were 
quartodecimans.  We  have  the  authority 
of  the  Emperor  Constaotine  himself  for 
saying  that  the  Britons  as  well  as  other 
nations  observed  Easter  as  the  Council  of 
Nica;a  directed  (Euseb.  de  Vit.  Constant. 
iii.  19). 

The  Celtic  Church,  or  the  British  and 
Irish  Christians,  adhered  to  the  old  Alex- 
andrian reckoning  adopted  at  the  Council  of 
Niccea  but  afterwards  discarded  by  the 
Church  in  Italy  for  one  made  by  Dionysius 
Exiguus,  A.D.  527,  which  was  thought  more 
accurate.  The  disciples  of  the  Celtic  school 
were  confirmed  in  their  obstinacy  by  the 
haughty  behaviour  of  the  Italian  priests. 
The  peculiar  tonsure  became  the  badge  of 
party  in  either  case  (Hook's  Archbishops, 
1,  13).  A  council  was  held  on  the  subject 
in  664,  at  Streaneshalch  (Whitby),  King 
Oswy  having  found  that  some  were  fasting 
in  Lent,  while  he  was  indulging  in  Easter 
festivities,  from  which  tune  the  Roman 
order  was  confirmed  in  Britain.  The  uni- 
form observance  of  Easter  was  enjoined  by 
Theodorus  (c.  671)  (See  Easter;  Oolden 
Number).      [H.] 

PASSALOEYNCHITES,  or  PATTA- 
LORYNCHIANS  {Uaa-aaXos,  a  gag,  and 
pvyxos,  a  muzzle).  Certain  heretics,  the 
followers  of  Montanus,  who  made  profes- 
sion of  never  speaking,  and  for  that  pur- 
pose always  held  their  fingers  upon  their 
mouths,  grounding  it  upon  certain  words 
of  the  140th  Psalm.  They  began  to  ap- 
pear in  the  second  age;  and  St.  Jerome 
testifies,  that  even  in  his  time  he  found 
some  of  them  in  Galatia,  as  he  travelled  to 
Ancyra. 

PASSION  SUNDAY.  From  very  early 
times  this  name  has  been  given  to  the 
Sunday  but  one  before  Good  Friday,  because 
on  that  day  our  Lord  began  to  speak  opeuly 
to   His  disciples  of  His  coming  sufferings 


PASSION  WEEK 

and  bitter  death.  It  was  called  Dominiac 
Passionis,  and  an  Anglo-Saxon  homily  for 
the  fifth  Sunday  in  Lent  commences  by 
stating  that  from  that  day  until  Easter, 
the  time  is  designated  Ohrisfs  Passiontide 
(Alfric's  Homilies,  ii.  224:  quoted  in  i>ict 
Christ.  Arit.  ii.  1564).  In  the  north  of 
England  this  is  called  "  Cai-ling  Sunday," 
and  parched  peas  are  eaten  under  the  name 
of  carlings.  It  is  mentioned  in  an  old 
rhyme  which  enumerates  the  Sundays  iu 
Lent  and  Easter-day : 

"Tid,  Mid,  Misere 
Carliug,  Palm,  and  Paste-egg  day." 

The  collect  is  taken  from  the  Sacramentary 
of  Gregory.  It  is  a  prayer  of  God's  people 
that  he  would  (1)  govern,  and  (2)  preserve 
them  both  in  body  and  soul.  The  Latin 
original  connects  the  "government"  with 
the  body,  and  the  "  preservation  "  with  the 
soul :  "  Ut  te  largiente  regatur  in  corpore, 
et  te  servante  custodiatur  in  mente."  The 
epistle  refers  to  our  Lord's  passion  (Heb. 
ix.  11-15) ;  the  gospel  to  the  rejection  of 
Him  by  "His  own,"  which  leads  up  to, 
and  prepares  us  for,  His  final  rejection. — E. 
Daniel's  P.  B. ;  Blunt's  House.  Theol.  p. 
222 ;  Annot.  P.  B. ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  [H.] 

PASSING  BELL,  or  Sovl  Pell.  A  bell 
tolled  when  a  soul  is  passing  out  of  this  life. 
It  was  originally  intended  to  call  all  within 
its  sound  to  prayer.  "  Art  thou  working  in 
the  field,  or  grinding  at  the  mill  ?  Remem- 
ber, then,  when  thou  hearest  the  sound  of 
the  bell  for  one  departing,  that  thou  put  up 
thy  prayers  for  him  "  (Bourne's  Art.  Vulg.). 

Durandus  (raVc.  a.d.  1190)  says  :  "  When 
any  one  is  dying,  a  bell  must  be  tolled  that 
the  people  may  offer  their  prayers.  Let  this 
be  done  twice  for  a  woman,  thrice  for  a  man  . . 
and  at  the  conclusion  a  peal  on  all  the  bells. 
A  bell  too  must  be  rung  while  we  are  con- 
ducting the  corpse  to  church,  and  during 
the  bringing  it  out  of  the  church  to  the 
grave  "  (Durand.  Rational,  pp.  13,  21).  In 
some  places  still  there  is  the  custom  of  toll- 
ing three  times  three,  distinctly,  for  a  man, 
three  times  two  for  a  woman,  and  three  for 
a  child.  But  the  original  intention  of  the 
"  passing  bell "  is  not  carried  out.  A  bell 
called  "  the  passing  bell  "  is  tolled,  but  it  is 
to  inform  the  people  that  a  death  has  taken 
place  (Brand's  Antiq.  p.  18).  By  the  sixth 
canon,  however,  it  is  enjoined,  "  When  any 
is  passing  out  of  this  life,  a  bell  shall  be 
tolled,  and  the  minister  shall  not  then  slack 
to  do  his  last  duty.  And  after  the  party's 
death  (if  so  it  fall  out)  there  shall  be  rung 
no  more  but  one  short  peal,  and  one  other 
before  the  burial,  and  one  other  after  the 
burial."     [H.] 

PASSION  WEEK.  The  week  following 
Palm  Sunday,  i.e.  the  week  in  which  the 
Passion  took  place.  The  name  has  sometimes- 


PASSIVE  OBEDIENCE 

been  given  to  the  previous  week,  on  tlie 
ground  that  the  iifth  Sunday  in  Lent 
is  called  Passion  Sunday  (q.v.) ;  but  in 
England  it  has  commonly  been  given  to 
the  last  week  in  Lent,  also  called  the 
"  Holy  Week  "  (See  Holy  Week  ;  Lent ; 
Maundy- Thursday ;  Good  Friday;  Easter 
Eve). 

PASSIVE  OBEDIENCE.  The  doctrine 
of  passive  obedience  is  that  it'  is  never  lawful 
for  the  people,  under  any  provocation  or 
pretext  whatever,  to  resist  their  kings  and 
sovereigns.  It  is  opposed  to  the  doctrine  of 
active  obedience  held  by  those  who  deem  it 
lawful  in  certain  cases  for  the  people  to 
oppose  their  rulers  and  kings. — Stubbs' 
Mosheim,  iii.  382.     [H.] 

PASSOVER  (Heb.  HDQ  ,  HD^n  JH  :  Gk. 
TO  irdcrxa  ;  a  leap  or  passage).  The  Passover 
was  a  solemn  festival  of  the  Jews,  instituted 
in  commemoration  of  then-  coming  out  of 
Egypt,  because  the  night  before  their  de- 
parture the  destroying  angel,  that  slew  the 
first-bom  of  the  Egyptians,  passed  over  the 
houses  of  the  Hebrews  without  entering 
them,  because  they  were  marked  with  the 
blood  of  the  lamb,  which  for  this  reason  was 
called  the  paschal  lamb.  For  full  account, 
see  Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible. 

PASTOR.  Literally,  a  shepherd ;  figur- 
atively, the  bishop  of  a  diocese,  or  the 
priest  of  a  parish,  whose  people  are,  like- 
wise, figuratively  called  their  flock.  It  is 
employed  in  this  sense  in  one  of  the  prayers 
for  the  Ember  Week,  and  in  the  Ordination 
services. 

PASTORAL  STAFF  (See  Crosier).  A 
staff  with  a  head  like  a  shepherd's  crook, 
which  is  carried  before,  or  borne  by  th  e  bishop. 
It  is  mentioned  in  one  of  the  rubrics  of  King 
Edward  VL's  First  Prayer  Book,  which  is 
stUl  the  law  of  the  Church,  according  to  the 
present  rubric  as  to  the  "  ornaments  of  the 
Church,"  except  so  far  as,  according  to 
recent  decisions  of  the  Privy  Council,  it  was 
modified  by  the  Advertisements  of  Queen 
Elizabeth  (See  Advertisements).  The  old 
rubric  prescribes  that  the  bishop  shall  in  his 
public  ministrations,  besides  his  proper 
vestments,  have  "his  pastoral  staff  in  his 
hand,  or  else  borne  or  holden  by  his  chap- 
lain." And  this  is  not  expressly  repealed 
by  the  Advertisements.  The  staff  of  an 
abbot  was  carried  with  the  crook  turned 
inwards,  implying  that  he  had  the  super- 
vision of  his  house  within ;  but  the  bishop's 
staff  was  borne  with  the  crook  facing  out- 
wards, to  denote  his  jurisdiction  over  his 
diocese.  The  bishop,  also,  carried  his  staff  in 
his  left  hand,  the  abbot  in  his  right  (Mas- 
kell,  Mon.  Bit.  iL  cl.).  Many  specimens 
of  pastoral  staffs  are  preserved,  as  that  of 
Wykeham  at  New  College ;  of  Pox  at  Corpus 
Christi    College :    of   Laud    at    St.   John's 


PATRIARCH 


5G7 


College ;  of  Smith  at  York ;  of  Mews  and 
Trelawney  at  Winchester.  In  the  British 
Museum  there  is  the  head  of  a  staff  with 
Limoges  enamel  of  the  13th  century ;  and 
another  of  about  the  same  date  from  Peter- 
borough; also  Lynd wood's  wooden  stafl', 
with  delicate  foliage,  of  the  15th  century ; 
and  a  bronze  staff  with  a  silver  head  which 
was  used  by  Archbishop  Finnen  of  Leinster, 
who  died  in  1108.  The  use  of  the  pastoral 
staff  has  of  late  years  been  revived,  and  in 
several  dioceses,  as  Salisbury,  Oxford,  Chi- 
chester, Rochester,  Bath  and  Wells,  &c., 
presentations  of  such,  beautifully  wrought, 
have  been  made  to  the  different  sees. — Wal- 
cott's  Sac.  Arch.  p.  430.     [H.] 

PATEN.  The  plate  on  which  the  sacred 
bread  in  the  Eucharist  is  laid.  The  original 
word  signifies  a  wide  open  dish.  It  occm-s 
in  the  rubric  of  our  Communion  Office,  at 
consecration,  "  here  the  priest  is  to  take 
the  paten  into  his  hands." 

PATERINL  The  Italian  name  for  the 
PauUcians  or  Manichajan  heretics  who  mi- 
grated from  Bulgaria  to  Italy  in  the  eleventh 
century ;  and  in  process  of  time  it  became 
the  common  appellation  of  all  heretics.  The 
name  was  also  given  by  way  of  reproach 
by  married  priests  to  such  friends  of  the 
pontiffs  as  disapproved  of  the  marriage  of 
clergymen.  The  Paterini  were  among  the 
sects  condemned  by  the  Lateran  Council 
A.D.  1179.— Stubbs'  Mosheim,  ii.  33 ;  Har- 
duim's  Cone.  vii.  163.     [H.] 

PATRIARCH.  A  name  originally  given 
to  all  bishops,  but  afterwards  restricted  to 
the  presiding  bishops  of  the  great  imperial 
dioceses,  and  still  later  to  the  five  greatest 
of  these,  viz.,  Rome,  Constantinople,  Alex- 
andria, Antioch,  and  Jerusalem.  A  Pa- 
triarch possessed  authority  over  the  me- 
tropolitans in  his  diocese  resembling  that 
exercised  by  the  latter  over  the  suffragan 
bishops  of  their  provinces.  The  date  at 
which  patriarchal  authority  was  established 
cannot  be  exactly  determined.  Many 
Romanist  writers  ascribe  its  estabUshment 
to  the  apostles,  but  this  is  almost  certainly 
wrong.  Some  think  that  there  were  pa- 
triarchs before  the  Council  of  Nicasa,  and 
that  the  famous  sixth  canon  of  that  Council 
implicitly  recognised  them.  Others  infer 
from  an  expression  of  the  historian  Socrates 
(hb.  V.  cap.  8)  that  patriarchates  were  es- 
tablished by  the  Council  of  Constantinople 
(a.d.  381).  This,  indeed,  seems  more  pro- 
bable inasmuch  as  in  this,  as  in  other  ar- 
rangements, the  Church  followed  the  exist- 
ing divisions  of  the  empire.  Constantino 
had  made  some  alterations  in  provincial 
government,  dividing  the  whole  empire 
into  thirteen  imperial  dioceses,  over  each 
of  which,  comprising  several  provinces,  a 
prefect  was  placed  (Gribbon,  cap.  xvii.  vol. 


568 


PATRIARCH 


iii.  p.  49,  12  vol.  ed.).  The  Church  then 
made  the  bishop  of  the  chief  city  of  these 
dioceses  the  primate  or  patriarch  of  the  dio- 
cese. The  privileges  of  patriarchs  were  the 
consecration  of  the  metropolitans  in  their 
dioceses,  the  convocation  of  diocesan  synods, 
appellate  and  visitatorial  jurisdiction  over 
metropolitans,  and  others  of  less  importance. 
But  these  privileges  were  not  the  same  in 
all  cases.  The  patriarch  of  Alexandria,  for 
instance,  had  the  right  of  consecrating  all 
the  bishops,  suffragan  as  well  as  metropoli- 
tan, within  his  patriarchate.  This  peculiar 
privilege  was  probably  due  to  the  fact  that 
the  bishop  of  Alexandria  was  at  one  time 
the  only  metropolitan,  as  well  as  the  only 
patriarch  in  his  diocese,  and  that  when 
metropolitans  were  set  up  in  subordination 
to  him  he  retained  some  of  his  metropo- 
litical  as  well  as  patriarchal  privileges. 

None  of  these  great  prelates  had  of  right 
any  supremacy  over  the  rest,  except  the 
patriarch  of  Constantinople,  who  assumed 
jurisdiction  over  the  Asian,  Pontic,  and 
Thracian  dioceses,  an  assumption  which, 
whatever  may  have  been  its  ground,  was 
legalized  by  the  Council  of  Chalcedon  (can. 
xxviii.).  'rhis  fact  by  itself  is  fatal  to  the 
claims  of  the  pope  to  universal  supremacy 
as  patriarch  of  the  west,  an  office  which  in 
fact  never  existed,  and  which,  if  it  had  ex- 
isted, would  by  no  means  have  given  the 
bishop  of  Rome  the  extravagant  authority 
which  he  claims.  There  were,  in  point  of 
fact,  besides  Rome,  four  patriarchates  in 
Western  Europe,  viz.,  Milan  for  the  dioceses 
of  Italy,  Lyons  for  that  of  Gaul,  Toledo 
for  Spain,  and  York  for  Britain.  The  patri- 
archal authority  of  the  bishop  of  Rome 
extended  only  over  the  imperial  diocese  of 
that  name — and  it  is  doubtful  whether  this 
comprised  the  territory  for  100  miles  round 
the  city,  or  included  the  ten  southern  pro- 
vinces of  Italy.  In  process  of  time,  how- 
ever, a  certain  primacy  (though  not  supre- 
macy) was  allowed  to  the  greater  patriarchs. 
Precedence  next  to  Rome  was  "iven  to  Con- 
stantinople by  the  second  General  Council 
(a.d.  381),  on  the  express  ground  that  it 
was  "  new  Rome  "  {Cone.  Constant,  can.  iii.), 
and  this  canon  was  ratified,  and  patriarchal 
authority  was  given,  by  the  Council  of 
Chalcedon  (can.  xxviii.).  The  Quiniseltine 
Council,  also  called  the  Council  in  Trullo, 
which  met  a.d.  691,  and  is  the  great  au- 
thority for  the  discipline  of  the  Eastern 
Church,  assigned  the  next  places  to  Alex- 
andria, Antioch,  and  Jerusalem  (Cone. 
Trull,  can.  xxxvi.).  It  is  now  usual  to 
confine  the  title  of  patriarch  to  the  holders 
of  these  five  great  sees. — Du  Pin,  Be  An- 
tiqua  Ecdesiae  Bisciplina,  Dissert,  i. ;  Bing- 
ham, .4n<tjuj<ies,  book  ii.  caps.  xvi.  andxvii., 
and  book  ix.  cap.  i. ;  Ussner,   Original  of 


PATRON 

Bishops  and  Metropolitans  (Works,  vol. 
vii.),  &c.     [H .] 

PATRIMON  y.  A  name  anciently  given 
to  church  estates,  or  revenues.  Thus  we 
find  mentioned,  in  the  letters  of  St.  Gregory, 
not  only  the  patrimony  of  the  Roman 
Church,  but  those  likewise  of  the  Churches 
of  Rimini,  Milan,  and  Ravenna.  This 
name,  therefore,  does  not  peculiarly  signify 
any  sovereign  dominion  or  jurisdiction  be- 
longing to  the  Roman  Church,  or  the  pope. 

Churches,  in  cities  whose  inhabitants  were 
but  of  modern  subsistence,  had  no  estates 
left  to  them  out  of  their  own  district :  but 
those  in  imperial  cities,  such  as  Rome, 
Ravenna,  ai>d  Milan,  where  senators,  and 
persons  of  the  first  rank,  inhabited,  were 
endowed  with  estates  in  divers  parts  of  the 
world.  St.  Gregory  mentions  the  patri- 
mony of  the  Church  of  Ravenna  in  Sicily, 
and  another  of  the  Church  of  Milan  in  that 
kingdom.  The  Roman  Church  had  patri- 
monies in  Prance,  Africa,  Sicily,  ia.  the 
Cottian  Alps,  and  in  many  other  countries. 
The  same  St.  Gregory  had  a  lawsuit  with 
the  bishop  of  Ravetma  for  the  patrimonies 
of  the  two  Churches,  which  afterwards  ended 
by  agreement. 

PA'l'RIPASSIANS  (a  patre  passo). 
A  denomination  that  arose  in  the  second 
century.  They  are  mentioned  by  Tertullian 
(^Adv.  Praxeas,  c.  i.)  and  St.  Cyprian,  his 
pupil  (Ep.  73).  Praxeas,  a  man  of  genius 
and  learning,  denied  any  real  distinction  be- 
tween the  I'ather,  Son,  and  Holy  Ghost,  and 
maintained  that  the  Father,  sole  Creator 
of  all  things,  had  united  to  Himself  the 
human  nature  of  Christ.  Hence  his  followers 
were  called  Monarchians,  because  of  their 
denying  a  plurality  of  persons  in  the  Deity ; 
and  also  Patripassians,  because  they  believed 
that  the  Father  was  so  intimately  united 
with  the  man  Christ,  His  Son,  that  He 
suffered  with  Him  the  anguish  of  an  afBicted 
life,  and  the  torments  of  an  ignominious 
death.  It  does  not  appear  that  this  sect 
formed  to  itself  any  separate  place  of 
worship,  or  removed  from  the  ordinary 
assemblies  of  Christians.  This  heresj' 
was  continued  by  Noetus,  Satellius,  and 
Priscillianus,  and  mingled  with  all  their 
several  heresies. — Pearson  on  the  Creed,  sec. 
158,  note. 

PA'l'RON.  The  person  who  has  the 
right  to  present  to  a  benefice.  The  great- 
est part  of  the  benefices  in  England  are 
presentative ;  the  thanes  or  lords,  who 
built  and  endowed  churches,  having  first 
agreed  with  the  bishops  that  they  should 
have  the  privilege  of  presenting  fit  clerks 
to  serve  and  receive  the  profits  of  the 
churches  founded  by  them  ;  which  right  is 
continued  to  their  ix)sterity,  and  those  who 
have  purchased  of  them.     See  the  14  &  15 


PATRON  SAINTS 

Vic.  c.  97,  for  a  new  legislative  right  of 
patronage  to  builders  and  endowers  of  new 
cliurclies,  and  church  building.  The  patron- 
age of  new  churches,  or  of  old  ones  when 
sold,  may  be  vested  in  five  trustees.  Mu- 
nicipal corporations  were  compelled  to  sell 
all  tlieir  livings,  and  many  were  bought  by 
Simeon's  trustees.  Some  old  trusts  consist 
of  a  much  larger  number :  e.g.  the  vicarage 
<if  Leeds  and  some  of  the  churches  there  are 
in  patronage  of  twenty-five  trustees. 

PATRON  SAINTS.  I.  In  the  very 
carhest  ages  of  Christianity  patron  saints,  or 
saints  supposed  to  regard  particularly  cer- 
tain places  or  professions,  do  not  seem  to 
have  been  recognised.  But  after  a  time  it 
liecame,  naturally  enough,  a  common  cus- 
tom to  connect  a  saint  or  martyr  with  the 
place  in  which  he  lived  or  suffered,  or  with 
the  profession  he  had  followed ;  which,  in- 
nocent in  itself,  afterwards  led  to  supersti- 
tious invocation  of  saints,  and  adoration  of 
relics.  As  earlv  as  the  time  of  St.  Ambrose 
(a.d.  386)  it  was  supposed  that  the  bodies 
(if  Gervasius  and  Protasius,  saints  buried 
at  Milan,  had  the  effect  of  healing  demoniacs 
who  were  brought  near  to  their  remains ; 
\\'herefore  Ambrose  said,  "  we  had  patrons, 
and  did  not  know  it"  {Epist.  xxii.  11;  see 
also  his  Expos,  in  Eu.  S.  Luc.  x.  12). 
Paulinus  of  Nola  wrote  in  his  metrical 
manner  on  the  subject,  and  doubtless  ex- 
tended the  usage  of  invoking  the  aid  of 
patron  saints  (see  Carm.  ii.  in  S.  Fel.  26). 
St.  Augustine  even  speaks  of  commending 
the  dead  to  the  saints  near  whom  they  were 
buried  (JDe  Curapro  Mort.  iv.  sec.  6).  Hence 
arose  the  custom  of  dedicating  a  church  to 
some  saint  or  martj'r  of  the  place ;  or,  if 
such  could  not  be  done,  of  dedicating  it  to 
some  otlier  saint,  in  hope  of  his  intercession. 
Thus  Theolindn,  about  a.d.  600,  built  a 
church  near  Milan  in  honour  of  St.  John 
Baptist,  that  he  might  be  an  intercessor  for 
iier  husband  and  children  (Mabillon,  Mus. 
Ital.  i.  210).  It  was  considered  in  the 
middle  ages  a  very  important  thing  to  have 
.some  relics  of  the  saint  to  whom  the  church 
was  dedicated,  as  they  would  be  a  protec- 
tion. 

**  Ita  suis  meritis  jam  tecta  sacrata  tuetur, 
Ut  procul  effugiat  hostis  ab  jede  sacra." 

— Alcuin,  Carvi.  35. 

II.  (i.)  In  the  middle  ages  persons  diseased 
had  their  "  patrons,"  or  saints  who  could 
miraculously  cure.  Tlius  St.  Koche  was 
supposed  to  cure  pestilence ;  St.  Apolonia, 
toothache ;  St.  Otilia,  bleared  eyes ;  St. 
Wolfgang,  the  gout ;  St.  Titus,  madness ; 
St.  Blaise,  the  quinsy,  or  any  affection  of 
the  throat. 

(ii.)  The  patron  saints  (ilefe.nsorei)  of 
professions  and  trades  were  so  esteemed 
because  (1)  they  had  been  followers  of  that 


TATEONAGE 


5G9 


calling — as  SS.  Peter  and  Andrew  are  pa- 
trons of  fishermen  and  fishmongers;  St. 
Joseph,  of  carixinters ;  St.  Crispin,  of  boot- 
makers :  (2)  from  some  incident  in  their  life, 
or  in  legends,  as  St.  Sebastian,  of  archers; 
St.  Dunstan,  of  goldsmiths ;  SS.  Hubert 
and  Eustace,  of  huntsmen ;  St.  Cecilia,  of 
musicians. 

(iii.)  Of  countries  and  of  cities  there 
were  always  patron  saints.  "  Merry  Eng- 
land "  claims  St.  George  and  St.  Mary ; 
Scotland,  St.  Andrew  ;  Ireland,  St.  Patrick  ; 
Wales,  St.  David;  France,  SS.  Mary, 
Michael,  and  Denis ;  Germany,  SS.  Martin, 
Boniface,  and  St.  George;  Austria,  SS. 
Colman  and  Leopold ;  Italy,  St.  Anthony ; 
Eussia,  SS.  Nicholas,  Andrew,  &c. ;  Spain, 
SS.  James  and  Edward ;  Portugal,  St. 
Sebastian.  A  full  list  can  be  found  in 
Walcotf's  Sacred  Archaiology,  p.  433. 

Many  cities  bear  the  name  of  their  patron 
saint,  as  St.  Alban's,  St.  Asaph,  St.  David's ; 
and  some  have  curious  contractions  in  the 
title — as  Boston,  for  St.  Botolph's  town; 
Malmesbury,  for  Maidulph's  burh;  Kirkcud- 
bright, for  St.  Cuthbert's  Church.     [H.] 

PATRONAGE  (See  Advowson ;  Collec- 
tion ;  Donatioe ;  Benefice  ;  Presentation). 
The  patron  of  a  living  is  the  person  or 
corporation  who  has  the  right  of  nominating 
the  incumbent  subject  to  his  being  accepted 
as  idoiieti^  by  the  bishop  of  the  diocese, 
within  the  legal  limits  of  his  discretion. 
When  the  bishop  of  tlie  diocese  (for  if 
may  be  another  bishop)  is  himself  the 
patron,  the  process  is  called  collation  :  other- 
wise the  patron  "  presents"  and  the  bishop 
"institutes"  (See  Benefice;  Institution; 
Advowson). 

All  patronage  of  livings  arose  from  the 
foundation  and  endowment  of  churches  by 
the  proprietors  of  land ;  and  the  present 
patrons  represent  them,  through  whatever 
changes  may  have  taken  place.  Many  ad- 
vowsons  are,  and  many  more  were,  "  appen- 
dant," i.e.  went  with  the  manor  by  convey- 
ance thereof  without  any  sijecial  mention 
of  the  advowson.  More  however  got.  sepa- 
rated, and  these  were  called  "  in  gross."  It  is 
the  fashion  now  to  talk  of  patronage  as  a 
"trust."  Whether  it  may  or  not  be  so 
called  morally,  there  is  certainly  no  legal 
authority  for  so  treating  it,  and  it  is  a  mere 
metaphorical  expression  which  cannot  logi- 
cally be  made  the  basis  of  any  argument, 
though  it  is  too  common  to  do  so.  The 
founder  of  a  church  built  it  and  endowed  it 
with  tithes  (see  Tithes),  imi  the  church  was 
adopted  into  the  ecclesiastical  system  of  the 
kingdom  subject  to  the  one  condition  that 
the  incumbent  was  to  be  idoneus  in  the 
judgment  of  the  bishop,  and  to  act  according 
to  the  laws  of  the  realm,  and  not  to  have 
obtained  the  appointment  by  what  the  law 


570 


PATRONAGE 


defines  as  simouy  (q.v.).  In  more  modern 
times  the  founders  of  cliurches,  having  very 
seldom  any  tithes  to  endow  them  with 
(though  impropriators  have  sometimes), 
endow  them  with  money,  or  get  the  endow- 
ment from  somebody  else,  and  settle  the 
patronage  by  agreement  in  any  of  the  ways 
authorised  by  law.  But  in  all  those  ways 
there  is  never  anything  like  a  trust  for  the 
parishioners.  Even  if  the  founder  chooses 
to  give,  or  to  let  the  patronage  go  to  trustees, 
under  some  of  the  Church-building  Acts, 
they  are  not  trustees  for  the  parish,  any 
more  than  if  the  advowson  went  to  trustees 
of  a  will  or  a  marriage  settlement,  but  are 
absolute  owners,  only  they  cannot  sell  it. 
In  a  few  cases  patronage  has  been  very 
unwisely  given  to  a  parish  collectively,  and 
it  has  generally  produced  the  worst  results. 
But  still  that  was  given  voluntarily  by  the 
founder  or  some  of  his  successors. 

It  is  ridiculous  to  talk  of  the  Crown  or 
the  bishops  or  deans  and  chapters  being 
trustees  for  the  parishes  of  livings  in  their 
gift;  and  if  they  are  not,  o /orft'oz-s  private 
owners  representing  the  original  founder 
are  not ;  and  therefore  it  is  mere  tyranny 
and  spoliation  to  deprive  them  of  the 
right,  which  they  reserved  when  they  or 
their  predecessors  founded  the  church,  to 
give  it  to  any  person  who  is  not  found  by 
the  proper  ecclesiastical  authority  unfit  to 
have  it.  It  may  be  that  the  proper  ecclesi- 
astical authorities  have,  either  by  negligence 
or  the  fear  of  litigation,  got  into  the  way  of 
not  testing  the  fitness  of  presentees  as  much 
as  they  ought,  and  there  is  no  doubt  that 
some  of  the  legal  decisions  have  been  such 
as  might  well  frighten  bishops  from  reject- 
ing presentees  whom  they  know  to  be  unfit. 
On  the  other  hand,  the  difficulty  in  the  way 
of  giving  them  more  discretion  is,  thatjjeople 
fear  it  would  sometimes  be  exercised  indis- 
creetly, or  in  accordance  with  theological 
prejudices.  But  the  practical  question  is 
whether  they  are  not  more  likely  to  be 
discreet  in  such  a  matter  than  any  body 
that  could  be  substituted  for  them,  and  who 
would  necessarily  be  whoUy  irresponsible, 
and  might  act  entirely  according  to  the 
prejudices  of  the  majority,  and  might  easily 
go  on  rejecting  every  presentee  except  one 
on  whom  they  had  fixed  their  own  choice — 
perhaps  a  popular  curate,  whom  neither 
a  bishop  nor  any  single  wise  patron  would 
think  fit  to  appoint.  Sooner  or  later  any 
such  "  council  of  patronage  "  as  church- 
reformers  want  is  certain  to  end  in  being 
elected  by  a  gradually  more  and  more 
popular  constituency,  until  it  would  end  in 
our  "  priests  being  made  "  by,  if  not  of,  "  the 
lowest  of  the  people,"  and  frequently  the 
worst  and  the  most  likely  to  destroy  the 
church.    Already  it  is  demanded  that  dis- 


PAULICIANS 

senters  should  be  electors,  and  they  are 
quite  certain  to  become  so  if  any  such 
scheme  is  enacted ;  for  nobody  will  listen  to 
any  kind  of  test  nowadays.     [G.] 

PAUL,  ST.,  THE  CONVEESION  OF. 
A  festival  of  the  Christian  Church,  observed 
on  the  twenty-fifth  of  January. 

The  Church  commemorates  St.  Paul  by  his 
Conversion,  because,  wonderful  in  itself,  and 
a  miraculous  effect  of  the  powerful  grace  of 
God,  it  was  of  the  highest  importance  to  the 
Church  of  Christ :  for,  while  the  other  Apostles 
had  their  particular  provinces,  he  had  the 
care  of  all  the  Churches,  and  was  especially 
called  the  Apostle  of  the  Gentiles.  Although 
the  collect  is  in  St.  Gregory's  Sacramentary, 
there  is  no  trace  of  a  festival  commemorating 
St.  Paul's  conversion  till  the  12th  century. 
But  it  is  supposed  that  the  martyrdom  of 
SS.  Peter  and  Paul,  which  according  to 
tradition  took  place  on  the  same  day,  was 
commemorated  on  Feb.  22,  the  day  which 
was  afterwards  called  Cathedra  Petri  (q.v.). 
In  the  Roman  calendar  the  double  comme- 
moration is  observed  on  June  29. 

PAULIANISTS.  Followers  of  Paul  of 
Samosata,  who  was  bishop  of  Antioch  a.d. 
260.  He  was  charged  with  holding  loose 
opinions  with  regard  to  morality,  and  of 
himself  conforming  to  those  opinions  (Eu- 
seb.  H.  E.  vii.  33 ;  Theod.  Bier.  fab.  ii.  8). 
But  he  further  propagated  heretical  ideas 
with  regard  to  the  Trinity,  deriving  his 
ideas  from  Artemon,  or  Artemas,  who  denied 
the  divinity  of  the  Second  and  Third  Persons- 
in  the  Trinity ;  and  asserted,  with  regard  to 
Christ,  that  after  His  birth,  as  mere  man,  a 
certain  portion  of  the  Divine  nature  was 
imparted  to  Him.  Paul  was  the  predecessor 
of  Arius  in  this  heresj^,  and  his  ideas  seem 
to  have  been  much  the  same.  The  learned 
reasoning  which  Paul  and  his  followers 
brought  to  bear  on  the  question  is  given  by 
Eusebius,  who  ends :  "  their  errors  are  derived 
from  the  abuse  of  the  arts  and  sciences  of 
the  infidels,  and  they  corrupt  the  simplicity 
of  the  gospel  by  the  refinements  of  human 
reason"  (if.  E.  v.  28).  This  heresy  was 
condemned  at  two  Councils  at  Antioch,  and 
at  the  Council  of  Nicaa,  and  was  particu- 
larly mentioned  in  the  Council  of  Ephesus 
(a.d.  431)  in  the  terms :  "  Concerning  the 
Incarnation  of  the  Word  of  Gfod,  the  Son  of 
the  Father,  a  definition  of  the  bishops  as- 
tembled  in  Nicasa,  and  a  declaration  of  that 
synod  against  Paul  of  Samosata"  suffices 
(Valerius,  Not.  on  Euseb.  H.  E.  vii.  30,  p. 
318).  The  Pauliani  are  also  mentioned  in 
the  Code  of  Theodosius  and  Valentinian,  in 
which  heretical  conventicles  are  forbidden. — 
Cod.  TJieod.  xvi.v.  65;  Labbe,.4d.  Cone.  Eph. 
vol.  iii:  Eouth,  Heliq.  iii.  300,  and  note 
320 ;  Gibbon's  Itoman  Empire,  c.  xvi. 

PAULICIANS.     Heretics  in  the  seventh. 


PAX 

ceutury,  disciples  of  Constantiiie,  a  native 
of  Armenia,  and  an  upholder  of  the  errors 
of  Manes  (See  Manichmans).  But  as  the 
name  of  Manichajans  was  become  odious  to 
all  nations,  he  gave  those  of  his  sect  the  title 
of  Pauhcians,  on  pretence  that  they  followed 
only  the  doctrine  of  St.  Paul.  Another 
derivation  of  the  name  is  however  given, 
viz.,  from  Paul,  an  Armenian  who  propa- 
gated the  heresy  in  Cappadocia  (Photius, 
Cont.  Manich.  lib.  i.).  The  Paulioians  held 
the  chief  errors  of  Manes,  though  they 
rejected  the  more  odious  parts  of  his  teach- 
ing. They  denied  the  grace  of  baptism  ;  and 
another  of  their  maxims  was,  not  to  give 
alms  to  the  poor,  that  they  might  not 
contribute  to  the  support  of  creatures  who 
were  the  work  of  the  bad  god. 

The  sect  of  the  Paulicians  did  not  spread 
much  till  the  age  of  the  emperor  Nice- 
phorus,  who  began  to  reign  in  801.  The 
protection  of  this  prince  drew  great  num- 
Ijers  to  their  party.  But  the  empress 
Theodora,  regent  during  the  minority  of  her 
son  Michael,  published  an  edict,  obliging 
them  to  follow  the  Catholic  faith,  or  to  depart 
out  of  the  empire.  Many  of  them  chose 
rather  to  suffer  death  than  to  obey;  and 
several,  who  lay  concealed,  afterwards  took 
up  arms  against  the  emperor  Basil,  the 
Macedonian. — P.  Siculus,  Hist.  Manich.  p. 
43 ;  Gibbon,  cliv. ;  Piobertson,  Ch.  Mist. 
ii.,  part  i.,  ch.  8. 

PAX  {Osculatorium).  A  small  tablet 
of  silver,  or  some  fit  material,  often  very 
elaborately  ornamented,  by  means  of  which 
the  kiss  of  peace  was,  in  the  mediaival 
Church,  circulated  through  the  congregation. 
It  was  introduced  when  the  primitive  kiss  of 
peace,  which  used  to  circulate  throughout 
the  Christian  assemblies,  was  discontinued 
on  account  of  some  appearance  of  scandal 
which  had  grown  out  of  it.  In  the  place 
of  this,  a  small  tablet  of  silver  or  ivory,  or 
some  appropriate  material,  having  first 
received  the  kiss  of  the  priest,  was  pre- 
sented by  him  to  the  deacon,  and  by  him 
again  to  the  people,  by  all  of  whom  it  was 
kissed  in  order;  thus  receiving  and  trans- 
mitting from  each  to  all  the  symbol  of 
Christian  love  and  imity,  without  any  pos- 
sibility of  offence.  Its  introduction  is 
attributed  to  the  Franciscans  (Bona,  Eer. 
Lit.  ii.  c.  xvi).  In  England  it  is  men- 
tioned at  York  in  1250,  and  in  the  Institu- 
tions of  Peckham  in  1280.  It  is  called  the 
"asser  ad  pacem"  in  a  Council  of  Oxford, 
1287;  the  "  paxillum"  of  St.  Paul's,  1298  ; 
the  "  tabula  pacis  "  in  the  Council  of  Merton, 
1300.  There  is  a  "pax"  of  silver  gOt  at 
New  College,  of  the  diate  of  Henry  IV. ;  and 
Chicheley  gave  one  of  glass  to  All  Souls' 
College.  At  Durham  the  embossed  cover  of 
the  book  of  the  gospels  and  epistles  served 


PEAC]-: 


571 


as  the  pax.  At  Doncastcr  in  1548  the 
clerk  took  the  pax  without  the  church  door, 
and  said  to  the  people,  "  This  is  a  token  of 
joyful  peace  betwixt  God  and  man's  con- 
science. Christ  alone  is  the  Peacemaker." 
But  it  was  omitted  at  the  lieformation  as  a 
useless  ceremony. — Tlieruryia  Anglicana  ; 
Scudamore's  Notil.  Eucharist,  p.  438 ;  Wal- 
cott's  Sac.  Arch.  p.  437.     [H.] 

PAX  VOBISCUM.  In  English,  "  Peace 
be  with  you."  A  form;  of  salutation  fre- 
quently made  use  of  in  the  ofiSces  of  the 
ancient  Christian  Church. 

I.  It  was  usual  for  the  bishop  to  salute 
the  people,  in  this  form,  at  his  first  entrance 
into  the  church.  This  is  often  mentioned 
by  St.  Chrysostom,  who  derives  it  from 
apostolical  practice  (^Hotn.  36  in  1  Cor. ; 
Horn.  3  in  Colos.). 

II.  The  reader  began  the  reading  of  the 
lessons  with  this  form.  St.  Augustine 
blames  the  Donatists  for  using  the  lormula 
when  they  were  separated  from  the  peace 
of  the  Churches  {Ep.  165),  and  other 
Fathers  refer  to  the  custom  (Bingham,  xiv. 
3).  The  third  Council  of  Carthage  (can.  4) 
took  away  this  privilege  from  the  readers, 
and  gave  it  to  the  deacons,  or  other  superior 
ministers  of  the  Church. 

III.  In  many  places,  the  sermon  was 
introduced  with  this  form  of  salutation,  and 
often  ended  with  it  (Constit.  Apost.  8.  c.  5  ; 
St.  Chrys.  Horn.  52). 

IV.  It  was  always  used  at  the  consecra- 
tion of  the  Eucharist ;  and 

V.  At  the  dismissal  of  the  congregation. 
And,  whenever  it  was  said  by  the  ofiSciating 
minister,  the  people  always  answered.  And' 
with  thy  spirit. 

St.  Chrysostom  la3's  open  the  oiiginal 
intent  and  design  of  this  practice.  For  he 
says,  it  was  an  ancient  custom  in  the  apos- 
tles' days,  when  the  rulers  of  the  Church 
had  the  gift  of  inspiration,  for  the  people 
to  say  to  the  preacher.  Peace  he  with  thy 
spirit;  acknowledging  thereby  that  they 
were  under  the  guidance  and  direction  of 
the  Spirit  of  God  (St.  Chrys.  Horn.  3  in 
Colos.). 

In  our  own  liturgj'  we  use  an  equivalent 
salutation,  namely,  Tlie  Lord  he  with  you  ; 
to  which  the  people  answer  (as  the  primi- 
tive Christians  did).  And  with  thy  spirit. 
It  occurs  but  twice  in  our  Prayer  Book,  i.e. 
after  the  Creed  at  Morning  and  Evening 
Prayer.  In  the  First  Book  of  King  Edward 
it  followed  the  versicles,  immediately  pre- 
ceding the  collect  for  the  day :  besides 
being  used  more  than  once  in  other  offices. 

PEACE,  COLLECTS  FOR.  The  differ- 
ence between  the  collect  used  in  the  Morning, 
and  that  in  the  Evening  Service  in  the 
Prayer  Book,  is  that  the  former  relates 
chiefly    to    outward   peace — -the    latter    tO' 


■■572 


PECULIAR 


inward  peace.  Both  collects  are  in  the 
Saoramentary  of  Gelasius  (a.d.  492),  and 
liave  probably  been  used  in  the  Church  of 
England  for  more  than  1200  years.  The 
morning  collect  is  translated  from  one  which 
was  used  at  Lauds  in  the  ancient  service,  and 
was  also  the  Post  Communion  prayer  of  a 
-special  Eucharistic  office  on  the  subject  of 
peace  (Missal.  Sar.  Com. ;  Missa  pro  pace  ; 
Post  Communio,  fol.  ccxli.).  The  evening 
-collect  was  used  in  the  prymer  of  the  14th 
■century,  "  Prei  we.  For  the  pees.  Deus  a 
quo.  God  of  whom  ben  hooli  desires,  &c." 
This  prayer  was  also  used  at  Lauds,  at 
Vespers,  and  in  the  Litanies  in  the  ancient 
services;  and  was  the  collect  of  the  same 
Jfissa  pro  pace,  of  which  the  Morning  col- 
lect was  the  "  first  communion." — Maskell, 
Mon.  Bit.  Ecc.  Ang.  iii.  38  ;  Blunt's  Annot. 
_P.  ]i.  i.  24,  38.     [H.] 

PECULIAR.  Those  parishes  and  places 
are  called  peculiars,  which  are  exempted 
from  the  jurisdiction  of  the  proper  ordinary 
■of  the  diocese  where  they  lie.  These  exempt 
jurisdictions  are  so  called,  not  because  they 
are  under  no  ordinary,  but  because  they  are 
not  under  the  ordinary  of  the  diocese,  but 
have  one  of  their  own.  Thej'  are  a  rem- 
nant of  popery.  The  pope,  before  the  Re- 
formation, by  a  usurped  authority,  in  defi- 
^ance  of  the  canons  of  the  Church,  exempted 
them  from  the  jurisdiction  of  the  bishop  of 
the  diocese.  At  the  Reformation,  by  an  over- 
sight, they  were  not  restored  to  the  jurisdic- 
tion of  the  diocese,  but  remained  under  the 
sovereign,  or  under  such  other  person  as 
■by  custom  or  purchase  had  obtained  the 
right  of  superintendence. 

The  Act  6  &  7  Will.  IV.  c.  77,  which 
■constituted  the  ecclesiastical  commission, 
•empowered  the  commissioners  "  to  propose 
that  those  parishes,  churches,  or  chapelries 
which  are  subject  to  any  peculiar  juris- 
diction, other  than  the  jurisdiction  of  the 
bishop  of  the  diocese  in  which  the  same  are 
locally  situate,  shall  be  only  subject  to  the 
jurisdiction  of  the  bishop  of  the  diocese 
within  which  such  parishes,  churches,  or 
chapelries  are  locally  situate  "  (Sect.  10).  In 
consequence  of  recommendations  by  the 
commissioners,  j^culiars  have  been  abolished 
everywhere,  unless  Westminster  Abbey  and 
the  chapels  of  the  Iims  of  Court  are  to  be 
reckoned  so.  They  are  certainly  not  subject 
to  the  bishop  of  London.     [G.] 

PELAGIANS.  Heretics  who  first  ap- 
peared about  the  latter  end  of  the  fourth, 
■  or  beginning  of  the  fifth,  century. 

Pelagius,  author  of  this  sect,  was  a  Bri- 
ton, being  born  in  Wales.  His  name,  in  the 
British  language,  was  Morgan,  which  signifies 
sea-born;  from  whence  he  had  his  name 
Pelagius  from  neXayos,  the  sea.  St.  Jerome, 
with  the  jealousy   which  has  often  been 


PELAGIANS 

displayed  by  continentals  against  natives  of 
this  country,  speaks  disparagingly  of  Pela- 
gius. He  describes  him  as  "  Scotorum  pul- 
tibus  praigravatus "  (Over  heavy  with  the 
porridge  of  the  Scots).  (Hier.  in  Prscfat. 
lib.  3,  in  Jeremias).  He  was  doubtless  a 
burly,  broad-shouldered  man,  but  the  charge 
of  voluptuousness  is  not  supported  on  any 
other  grounds  (Paulus  Orosius  in  Apolog. 
c.  21;  Baronius,  Ant.  v.  p.  305).  He  is 
said  to  have  been  a  monk  by  profession ;  but 
probably  he  was  so  only  in  the  sense  in  which 
those  were  so  called  who  led  stricter  lives 
than  others  v.'ithin  their  own  houses.  Some 
of  our  ancient  historians  assert  that  he 
was  abbot  ot^  Bangor  (Ussher,  Ecdes.  Brit. 
Ant.  c.  viii.  ix.).  But  this  is  not  likely, 
because  theBritish  monasterieswere  probably 
of  a  later  date.  St.  A(Ligustine  gives  him 
the  character  of  a  very  pious  man,  and  a 
Christian  of  no  vulgar  rank.  According  to 
the  same  Father  he  travelled  to  Rome,  where 
he  associated  himself  with  persons  of  the 
greatest  learning  and  distinction.  Here  he 
instructed  several  young  persons,  particularly 
Coelestius  and  Julianus ;  as  also  Timasius 
and  Jacobus,  who  afterwards  renounced 
his  doctrine,  and  applied  themselves  to  St. 
Augustine.  During  this  time  he  wrote  his 
"  Commentaries  on  St.  Paul's  Epistles,"  and 
his  Letters  to  Melania  and  Demetrias  (Aug. 
de  Peccat.  Mer.  Rem.  iii.;  Ep.  186,  &c.). 

Pelagius,  being  charged  with  heresy,  left 
Rome,  and  went  into  Africa,  where  be 
was  present  at  the  famous  conference  held 
at  Carthage,  between  the  CathoUcs  and 
Donatists.  Prom  Carthage  he  travelled  into 
Egypt,  and  at  last  went  to  Jerusalem,  where 
he  settled.  He  was  accused  before  the  Coun- 
cil of  Diospolis  in  Palestine,  where  he  re- 
canted his  opinions;  but  relapsing,  and  dis- 
covering the  insincerity  of  his  recantation,  he 
was  afterwards  condemned  by  several  coun- 
cils in  Africa,  and  by  a  synod  at  Antioch. 
Pelagius  died  somewhere  in  the  East,  but 
where  is  uncertain.  His  principal  tenets,  as 
we  find  them  charged  upon  his  disciple  Cseles- 
tius  by  the  Church  of  Carthage,  were  these  : 

I.  That  Adam  was  by  nature  mortal, 
and,  whether  he  had  sinned  or  not,  would 
certainly  have  died. 

II.  That  the  consequences  of  Adam's  sin 
were  confined  to  his  person,  and  the  rest  of 
mankind  received  no  disadvantage  thereby. 

III.  That  the  law  qualified  men  for  the 
kingdom  of  heaven,  and  was  founded  upon 
equal  promises  with  the  gospel. 

IV.  That,   before  the  coming  of  our 
Saviour,  some  men  lived  without  sin. 

V.  That  new-born  infants  are  in  the 
same  condition  with  Adam  before  his  fall. 

VI.  That  the  general  resurrection  of  the 
dead  does  not  follow  in  virtue  of  our  Saviour's 
resuiTeotion. 


PELAGIANS 

VII.  That  a  man  may  keep  the  com- 
niauds  of  God  without  difficulty,  and  pre- 
serve himself  in  a  iierfect  state  of  imio- 
cence. 

VIII.  That  rich  men  cannot  enter  into  the 
kingdom  of  heaven,  unless  they  part  with  all 
their  estate. 

IX.  That  the  grace  of  God  is  not 
granted  for  the  perfoniiance  of  every  moral 
act ;  the  liberty  of  the  will,  and  information 
in  points  of  duty,  being  sufficient  for  this 
purpose. 

X.  That  the  grace  of  God  is  given  in  pro- 
portion to  our  merits. 

XI.  That  none  can  be  called  the  sons  of 
God,  but  those  who  are  perfectly  free  from 
sin. 

XII.  That  our'victory  over  temptation  is 
not  gained  by  God's  assistance,  but  by  the 
liberty  of  the  will. 

As  we  get  our  information  from  Pelagius' 
adversaries ;  and  as  he  used  certain  words, 
e.g.  "grace,"  with  a  different  meaning  to  the 
Augustinian  meaning,  there  is  considerable 
difficulty  in  arriving  at  what  Pelagius  really 
taught.  But  the  chief  points  seem  to  be  : 
1.  The  denial  of  original  sin.  2.  The  denial 
of  the  necessity  of  grace.  3.  The  assertion 
of  complete  free  will,  and  therefore  the 
possibility  of  a  sinless  man. 

The  third  General  Council  (of  Epheaus) 
(a.d.  431)  thus  disposes  of  this  heresy: 
"  The  holy  Synod  gives  it  in  charge  that  all 
who  fall  away,  and  either  publicly  or 
privately  adhere  to  the  opinions  of  Nestorius 
and  Cffilestius  (the  disciple  of  Pelagius)  be 
deposed"(Can.  1,  4). 

The  heresy  of  Pelagius,  notwithstanding 
its  condemnation,  made  its  way  into  Britain, 
where  its  author  was  born ;  beitig  conveyed 
thither  by  one  Agricola,  the  son  of  Severia- 
nus,  a  Pelagian  bishop  of  Gaul.  The  ortho- 
dox party  were  very  diligent  in  opposing  its 
progress,"  and  for  that  purpose  requested  the 
Galilean  bishops  to  send  over  some  persons 
of  eminence  to  manage  the  contest.  It  is 
important  to  observe  this,  as  Romanists  of 
course  claim  that  the  bishops  were  sent 
by  the  bishop  or  pope  of  Kome  (Baronius, 
Annales,  vol.  v.  pp.  351-532).  But  it  was 
not  so,  as  they  started  on  their  mission 
before  any  communication  could  have  been 
held  with  Rome  (Constant,  de  Vita  German. 
i.  c.  19 ;  Bede,  Ecd.  Hist.  i.  c.  19).  Those 
chosen  for  this  purpose  were  Germanus, 
bishop  of  Auxerre,  and  Lupus,  bishop  of 
Troyes;  who,  an-iving  in  Britain,  held  a 
famous  conference  with  the  Pelagians  at 
St.  Alban's,  in  which  the  latter  were  put  to 
silence,  and  the  people  gave  sentence,  by 
their  acclamations,  for  Germanus  and  Lupus. 
The  Pelagian  error  respecting  original  sin  is 
noticed  in  our  ninth  Article.  Tliis  heresy 
is   treated  by  St.  Augustine  in  many  of 


PENANCE 


573- 


his  books,  as  Enchiridion,  lib.  i.  :  contra 
duas  Epistolas  Pelxgianor um  ad  Bonifa- 
cium,  lib.  iv. :  Epistola  ad  Vahrium,  Paul- 
inum,  Optatmii;  Cmlestinum,  &c.,  &c.  See 
also  Bede,  u.  s. ;  Ussher's  Britan.Eccles.  Ant.. 
cc.  viii.-xi.  ;  Walch,  Ifist.  der  Ketzereien, 
iv.  735 ;  Tillemont's  Memoires,  colix.- 
cclxxxvi. ;  Newman's  Fleury,  //.  E.  xxiii. 
1,  seq. ;  Stubbs'  Moslieim,  vol.  i.  379,  382. 

PENANCE  (Pccnitentia).  As  repen- 
tance is  the  principle  and  inward  feeling  of 
sorrow  for  sin,  which  we  are  determined  to 
forsake,  so  penance  is  the  outward  profession 
of  that  sorrow. 

I.  Penance,  in  the  Christian  Church,  is 
an  imitation  of  the  discipline  of  the  .Jewish 
synagogue ;  or,  rather,  it  is  a  continuatiou 
of  the  same  institution.  Excommunication 
in  the  Christian  Church  is  essentially  the 
same  as  expulsion  from  the  synagogue  of  the 
Jews;  and  the  penances  of  the  offender, 
required  for  his  restoration  to  his  former 
condition,  were  not  materially  different  in 
the  Jewish  and  Christian.  Churches.  'I'hc 
principal  point  of  distinction  consisted  in 
this,  that  the  sentence  of  excommunication 
affected  the  civil  relations  of  the  offender 
under  the  Jewish  economy;  but  in  the' 
Christian  Church  it  affected  onl}'  his  rela- 
tions to  that  body.  Neither  the  spirit  of 
the  primitive  institutions  of  the  Church, 
nor  its  situation,  nor  constitution  in  the  first 
three  centuries,  was  at  all  compatible  with 
the  intermingling  or  confounding  of  civil  and 
religious  privileges  or  penalties. 

The  act  of  excommunication  was,  at  first, 
an  exclusion  of  the  offender  from  the  Lord's 
supper,  and  from  the  agapx.  The  term 
itself  implies  separation  from  the  communion. 
The  practice  was  derived  from  the  injunction 
of  the  apostle,  1  Cor.  v.  11,  "  With  such  an 
one  no  not  to  eat."  From  the  context,  and 
from  1  Cor.  x.  16-18  :  xi.  20-34,  it  clearly 
appears  that  the  apostle  refers,  not  to  com- 
mon meals,  and  the  ordinary  intercourse  of 
hfe,  but  to  these  religious  festivals. 

Examples  of  penitence  or  reiDentance  ocour 
in  the  Old  Testament ;  neither  are  there' 
wanting  instances,  not  merely  of  individu'^ls, 
but  of  a  whole  city  or  people,  performing 
certain  acts  of  penance, — fasting,  mourning, 
&c.  (Nehem.  ix. .  Jonah  iii.).  But  these 
acts  of  humiliation  were  essentially  different, 
in  their  relations  to  individuals,  from  Chris- 
tian penance. 

We  have,  however,  in  the  New  Testament, 
an  instance  of  the  excommunication  of  an 
offending  member,  who  had  married  his 
stepmother,  and  of  his  restoration  to  the 
fellowship  of  the  Church  by  penance,  agree- 
ably to  the  authority  of  St.  Paul,  1  Cor. 
V.  1-8.  This  sentence  of  exclusion  from  the 
Church  was  pronounced  hy  the  assembled 
body,  and  in  the  name  of  the  Lord  Jesus- 


57-i 


PEXANCE 


Christ.  By  this  sentence,  the  offender  was 
separated  from  the  people  of  the  Lord,  with 
whom  he  had  heen  joined  h}'  haptism,  and 
was  reduced  to  his  former  condition  as  a 
heathen  man,  suhject  to  the  power  of  Sa- 
tan, and  of  evil  spirits.  This  is,  perhaps, 
the  true  import  of  "  delivering  such  an  one 
up  to  Satan."  It  appears  from  2  Cor.  ii. 
1-11,  that  the  Church  had  not  restored  the 
offender  to  the  privileges  of  communion, 
when  they  received  the  second  epistle,  but 
were  willing  to  do  so ;  and  that  the  apostle, 
after  hearing  of  the  punishment  and  penance, 
veij  gladly  authorised  the  measure.  This 
punishment  by  excommunication  is  referred 
to  again  by  St.  Paul :  "  if  any  man  love  not 
the  Lord  Jesus  Christ,  let  him  be  anathema." 
1  Cor.  xvi.  22  (See  Anathema).  The 
offender  was  to  be  excluded  from  communion 
and  fellowship  with  the  faithful ;  so  that  he 
should  no  longer  he  considered  as  one  of 
their  body. 

It  is  important  to  remark,  that,  in  the 
primitive  Church,  penance  related  only  to 
such  as  had  been  excluded  from  the  com- 
munion of  the  Church.  Its  immediate  object 
was,  not  the  forgiveness  of  the  offender  by 
the  Lord  God,  but  his  reconciliation  with  the 
Church.  It  conld,  therefore,  relate  only  to 
open  and  scandalous  offences.  "  De  occultis 
nou  judicat  ecclesia" — the  Church  takes  no 
cognizance  of  secret  sins — was  an  ancient 
maxim  of  the  Church.  The  early  Fathers 
say  expressly,  that  the  Church  offers  pardon 
cinly  for  offences  committed  against  her. 
The  forgiveness  of  all  siar  she  refers  to  God 
himself.  "  Omnia  autem,"  says  Cyprian  (Ep. 
55),  "  remisimus  Deo  omnipotenti,  in  cujus 
potestate  sunt  omnia  reservatn."  Such  are 
the  concurring  sentiments  of  most  of  the 
early  writers  on  this  subject.  It  was  re- 
served for  a  later  age  to  confound  these  im- 
portant distinctions,  and  to  arrogate  to  the 
Church  the  prerogative  of  forgiving  sins. 

The  readmission  of  penitents  into  the 
Church  was  the  subject  of  frequent  contro- 
versy with  the  early  Fathers,  and  ancient 
religious  sects.  Some  contended  that  those 
who  had  once  been  excluded  from  the  Church 
for  their  crimes  ought  never  again  to  be 
received  to  her  fellowship  and  communion. 
But  the  Church  generally  was  disposed  to 
exercise  a  more  charitable  and  forgiving 
spirit.  There  were,  however,  very  severe 
forms  of  penance  ordained  for  offenders. 
Thus  Tertullian  says  that  public  penance 
obliges  the  sinner  to  change  his  dress  and 
his  manner  of  living,  and  to  lie  in  sackcloth 
and  ashes.  "  De  ipso  quoque  habitu  atque 
victu  mandat,  sacco  et  cineri,  incubare,  cor- 
pus sordibus  obscurare "  {^De  Pcenit.  c.  9 ; 
also,  to  the  same  effect,  Ambrose,  ad  Virg. 
lapsain ;  Cypr.  de  lapsis ;  Euseb.  lib.  v. 
c.  28).     And  no  sinner  was  absolved  till  he 


TENANCE 

had  performed  his  regular  penance,  and  had 
carefully  gone  through  the  several  stages  of 
discipline  (Bingham,  bk.  xix.  c.  2).  It 
is  to  this  that  reference  is  made  in  the  com- 
mination  service:  "there  was  a  godly 
discipline  in  the  Primitive  Church  that  such 
persons  as  stood  convicted  of  notorious  sin 
were  put  to  open  penance,"  &c.  (See  Com- 
mination'). 

II.  In  the  law  of  England  penance  was  an 
ecclesiastical  punishment  or  penalty,  used 
in  the  discipline  of  the  Church  of  England, 
by  which  an  offender  was  obliged  to  give  a 
public  satisfaction  to  the  Church  for  scandal 
done  by  his  evil  example.  For  small  offences 
and  scandals,  a  public  satisfaction  or  pen- 
ance was  required  to  be  made  before  the 
minister,  churchwardens,  and  some  of  the 
parishioners,  as  the  ecclesiastical  judge  should 
think  fit  to  decree.  These  penances  might 
be  moderated  at  the  discretion  of  the  judge, 
or  commuted  for  money  to  be  devoted  to 
pious  uses.  In  the  case  of  incest  or 
incontinency  the  offender  was  sometimes 
enjoined  to  do  public  penance  in  the  ca- 
thedral, the  parish  church,  or  the  market- 
place, bare-legged,  bare-headed,  and  in  a 
white  sheet,  and  to  make  open  confession  of 
his  crime  in  a  form  of  words  prescribed  by 
the  judge.  The  two  latest  instances  of 
public  penance  in  England  occurred  at  Bristol 
in  1812,  and  at  Ditton  in  1849.  This  sort 
of  punishment,  however,  being  contrary  to 
the  spirit  of  the  age,  and  the  profiigate  being 
found  to  make  parties  to  abet  the  offender, 
it  has  fallen  into  desuetude,  though  not 
abolished  by  legislation.     [H.] 

III.  The  Council  of  Trent  (sess.  14,  can.  1) 
decreed,  that  every  one  is  accursed  who 
shall  affirm  that  penance  is  not  truly  and  pro- 
perly a  sacrament  instituted  by  Christ  in 
the  universal  Church,  for  reconciling  those 
Christians  to  the  Divine  majesty  who  have 
fallen  into  sin  after  baptism;  and  this 
sacrament,  it  is  declared,  consists  of  two 
parts — the  matter  and  the  form  :  the  matter 
is  the  act  of  the  penitent,  including  contri- 
tion, confession,  and  satisfaction;  the  form 
of  it  is  the  act  of  absolution  on  the  part  of 
the  priest  (See  Absolution).  Accordingly 
every  maa  is  enjoined  to  confess  his  sins 
once  a  year,  at  least,  to  a  priest,  which  con- 
fession is  to  be  secret.  This  secret  or  auricu- 
lar confession  was  first  decreed  and  estab- 
lished in  the  fourth  Council  of  Lateran,  under 
Innocent  III.,  in  1215  (cap.  21).  As  for 
the  penances  imposed  on  the  penitent  bj"- 
way  of  satisfaction,  they  have  been  com- 
monly the  repetition  of  certain  forms  of 
devotion,  as  Paternosters  or  Ave-Marias, 
the  payment  of  stipulated  sums,  pilgrim- 
ages, fasts,  or  various  species  of  corporeal 
discipline.  But  the  most  formidable  pen- 
ance, in  the  estimation  of  many  who  have 


PENITENTIATi 

belonged  to  the  Roman  communion,  has 
been  the  temporaiy  pains  of  purgatory. 
But,  under  all  the  penalties  which  are  in- 
flicted or  threatened  in  the  Romish  Church, 
it  has  provided  relief  by  its  indulgences,  and 
by  its  prayers  or  masses  for  the  dead, 
performed  professedly  for  relieving  and 
rescuing  the  souls  that  are  detained  in  pur- 
gatory (See  Indulgences ;  Pardons ;  Ex- 
communication). 

The  reader  need  scarcely  be  reminded 
how  entirely  opposed  all  this  is  to  the 
doctrine  of  the  Church  of  England.  The 
Church  of  Rome  afBrms  "  penance  "  to  be 
a  "sacrament,"  instituted  by  Christ  him- 
self, and  secret  "confession"  to  be  one  of 
its  constituent  parts,  instituted  by  the 
Divine  law;  and  she  anathematizes  those 
who  contradict  her: — the  Church  of  Eng- 
land denies  "penance"  to  be  a  sacrament 
of  the  gospel;  affirms  it  to  have  "grown 
of  the  corrupt  following  of  the  apostles;" 
and  "  not  to  have  "  the  proper  "  nature  of  a 
sacrament,"  as  "  not  having  any  visible  sign 
or  ceremony  ordained  of  God ; "  and  of 
course  denies  the  sacramental  character  of 
"  confession."  This  latter  point  has  already 
been  considered  (see  Auricular  Confession). 
It  has  only  to  be  further  observed,  in  the 
first  place,  that  as  the  Church  of  England  in 
her  Commination  Service,  speaks  of  the 
ancient  ordinance  of  open  penance  as  "  a 
discipline"  the  restoration  of  which  is 
"  much  to  be  wished,"  she  hereby  recog- 
nises the  ancient  systems  essentially  dif- 
ferent from  that  of  Rome :  namely,  a  public 
expression  of  sorrow  and  repentance,  to 
satisfy  the  congregation,  scandalized  by 
the  offence;  not  as  a  private  purchase  of 
indemnity  to  the  individual :  and,  in  the 
next  place,  when  she  uses  the  word  penance, 
in  the  second  exhortation  in  the  same 
service,  "  Seeking  to  bring  forth  worthy 
fruits  of  penance,"  she  but  quotes  the 
words  of  St.  John  the  Baptist  (St.  Luke 
iii.  8),  and  thus  identifies  penance  with  re- 
pentance, iicrdvoia,  that  is,  change  of  mind 
or  heart.  So  that  the  outward  penance  is 
the  mere  outward  symbol  of  the  inward 
repentance. 

PENITENTIAL  (Pcenitentiale :  liber 
pcenitentialis :  pcenitentiales  Codices,  Li- 
helU,  &c.).  A  collection  of  canons  which 
appointed  the  time  and  manner  of  penance 
to  be  regularly  imposed  for  every  sin,  and 
forms  of  prayer  that  were  to  be  used  for  the 
receiving  of  those  who  entered  into  penance, 
and  reconciling  penitents  by  solemn  absolu- 
tion. The  use  of  the  penitential  is  described 
by  Morinus:  "Interrogato  confitente,  con- 
fessor statim  promebat  librum  suum  poeni- 
tentialem,  qua?sito  que  in  eo  delicto,  locum 
«i  ostendebat,  ut  videret  ipse  agnosceret- 
que,   legitimam  sibi  imponi  pcenitentiam " 


PENITENTIARIES 


575 


(Ducange,  Gloss.).  But  its  chief  intention 
was  that  penance  should  be  imposed  accord- 
ing to  its  regulations,  and  not  at  the  discre- 
tion of  the  individual  confessor. 

With  regard  to  the  early  history  of  these 
penitentials,  little  is  known,  but  it  is  pro- 
bable that  each  bishop  with  his  presbytery 
administered  the  discipline  of  his  diocese  on 
certain  fixed  principles  derived  from  the 
primitive  ideas  of  penance.  It  would  then 
be  naturally  the  case  that  the  rules  of  those 
bishops  who  gained  a  high  reputation  from 
strength  of  character,  or  wisdom,  should  be 
accepted  by  others.  Thus  the  epistles  of 
Basil,  and  his  brother  Gregory  of  Nyssa,  on 
penance,  were  received  as  of  high,  almost 
canonical  authority.  The  Couucil  of  Glove- 
sho,  A.D.  747  (can.  6),  forbids  any  man  to 
be  ordained  priest  who  has  not  his  peniten- 
tial (WUkins,  Cone.  i.  95).  The  best 
known  are  the  Anglo-Saxon  penitentials  of 
the  seventh  and  eighth  centuries.  That 
which  is  called  the  "  Pcenitentiale  Theodori " 
appears  not  to  have  been  Archbishop  Theo- 
dore's composition,  but  taken  from  some 
earlier  works,  as  Dr.  Wasserschleben  has 
shown  from  original  research  on  the  conti- 
nent. Doctor  Stabbs  (Bishop  of  Chester) 
and  the  late  Rev.  A.  W.  Haddan  discovered 
a  copy  of  the  work  in  MS.  (320),  in  the 
library  of  Corpus  Christi  College,  Cambridge, 
in  which  reference  is  made  to  "quibusdam 
codicibus,"  indicating  that  the  original  MS. 
has  not  been  discovered.- — Haddan  and 
Stubbs,  iii.  1731. 

There  is  also  a  penitential  of  Bede,  and 
of  Egbert,  called  also  "  scrift-bok,"  which 
has  been  published  (Thorpe's  Anc,  Laws 
and  Inst. ;  Wilkins,  Cone.  i.  113).  In  the 
British  Museum  among  the  roj'al  MSS.  is  a 
"  Liber  Poenitentialis  "  of  the  early  part  of 
the  14th  century.  This  is  said  to  have 
been  compiled  by  Bartholomew,  bishop  of 
Exeter  a.d.  1162.  See  Diet.  Christ.  Ant. ; 
Maskell,  Mon.  Hit.  i.,  cxviii.     [H.] 

PENITENTIAL  PSALMS  (See 
Psalms). 

PENITENTIARIES,  in  the  ancient 
Christian  Church,  were  certain  presbyters, 
or  priests,  appointed  in  every  church,  to 
receive  the  private  confessions  of  the  people ; 
not  in  prejudice  to  the  public  discipline,  nor 
with  a  power  of  granting  absolution  before 
any  penance  was  performed,  but  to  facilitate 
the  exercise  of  public  discipline,  by  ac- 
quainting men  what  sins  the  laws  of  the 
Church  required  to  be  expiated  by  public 
penance,  and  by  directing  them  in  the  per- 
formance of  it ;  and  only  to  appoint  private 
penance  for  such  private  crimes  as  were  not 
proper  to  be  publicly  censured,  either  for 
fear  of  doing  harm  to  the  penitent  himself, 
or  giving  scandal  to  the  Church  (Socrat. 
//.  B.  V.  19 ;  Soz.  //.  E.  vii.  16). 


576 


PENITENTS 


The  office  of  penitentiary  priests  was 
abrogated  by  Nectarius,  bishop  of  Con- 
stantinople, in  the  reign  of  Theodosius, 
on  account  of  a  certain  scandal  that  had 
arisen  in  the  Churcli.  Tlie  bishop,  perceiv- 
ing the  danger  and  the  difficulty  of  carrying 
it  on  without  offence,  by  the  advice  of 
Eudajmon,  took  away  the  penitentiary's 
office, leaving  everj'one  to  his  own  conscience; 
ihis  being  the  only  way  to  free  the  Church 
from  reproach. 

Nectarius's  example  was  followed  by  all 
Ibe  bishops  of  the  East,  who  took  away 
then'  penitentiaries  and  discountenanced 
secret  confessions,  baronius  objects  to  the 
authenticity  of  this  proceeding  on  Nec- 
tarius's  part,  that  it  rests  on  the  authority 
of  Sozomen,  Socrates,  and  Buda^mon,  who 
were  Novatians  (Baron,  torn.  i.  c.  26).  But 
this  is  only  an  assertion,  and  Socrates 
disapproved  of  Nectarius's  action.  Bellar- 
mine  gives  up  this  point,  but  asserts  that 
public  confession,  not  private,  was  taken 
away  (Bellarm.  de  Pcenit.  lib.  iii.  c.  14), 
which  point,  however,  he  does  not  prove. 
The  office  continued  in  use  in  the  Western 
Churches,  and  chiefly  at  l?ome.  A  digni- 
tary in  many  of  the  foreign  cathedrals  is  so 
called. — Hooker's  Ecc.  Pol.  vi.,  iv.  9. 

PENITENTS.  I.  Those  who,  having 
fallen  into  sin,  submitted  to  the  i-ules  of 
discipline,  and  performed  penance  until 
their  readmission  into  the  Church  (See 
Penance).  Tlie  duration  of  their  penance 
varied  at  different  periods,  and  according  to 
the  heinousness  of  the  oflence.  By  the  Apo- 
stolic Constitutions,  the  offenders  when  they 
professed  their  repentance  were  to  be 
separated  some  determinate  time— as  two, 
three,  five,  or  seven  weeks — and  afterwards 
received  again  (Bk.  ii.  16).  In  Afi'ica  the 
term  does  not  seem  to  have  exceeded  one  or 
two  years ;  and  St.  Cyprian  at  one  time 
certainly  admitted  the  "  lapsi "  after  a  much 
shorter  penance  (Epp.  57,  59).  But  later 
councils  imposed  a  much  longer  term — five 
to  twenty  years.  There  were  four  classes 
of  penitents:  the  mourners  (fientes);  the 
hearers  (audientes);  the  kneelers  (sub- 
strati)  ;  and  the  co-standers  (consistentes). 
The  duties  required  of  penitents  consisted 
essentially  in  the  following  particulars : — 

1.  Penitents  of  the  first  three  classes 
were  required  to  kneel  in  worship,  whilst 
the  faithful  were  permitted  to  stand. 

2.  All  were  required  to  make  known 
their  penitential  son'ow  by  an  open  and 
public  confession  of  their  sin.  This  con- 
fession was  to  be  made,  not  before  the 
bishop  or  the  priesthood,  but  in  the  pre- 
sence of  the  whole  Church,  with  sighs,  and 
tears,  and  lamentations.  These  expressions 
of  grief  they  were  to  renew  and  continue 
so    long  as  they  remained   in  the  first  or 


PENITENTS 

lowest  class  of  penitents,  entreating  at  the 
same  time,  in  their  behalf,  the  prayers  and 
intercessions  of  the  faithful.  Some  idea  of 
the  nature  of  these  demonstrations  of  peni- 
tence may  be  formed  from  a  record  of  them 
contamed  in  the  works  of  Cyprian.  Al- 
most all  the  canons  lay  much  stress  upon 
the  sighs  and  tears  accompanying  these 
effusions. 

3.  Throughout  the  whole  term  of  pen- 
ance, all  expressions  of  joy  were  to  be  re- 
strained, and  all  ornaments  of  dress  to  be 
laid  aside.  The  penitents  were  required, 
literally,  to  wear  sackcloth,  and  to  cover 
their  heads  with  ashes.  Nor  were  these 
acts  of  humiliRtion  restricted  to  Ash  Wed- 
nesday merely,  but  then  especially  they 
were  required. 

4.  The  men  were  required  to  cut  short 
their  hair,  and  to  shave  their  beards,  in 
token  of  sorrow.  The  women  were  to 
appear  with  dishevelled  hair,  and  wearing  a 
peculiar  kind  of  veil. 

5.  During  the  whole  term  of  penance, 
bathing,  feasting,  and  sensual  gratifications, 
allowable  at  other  times,  were  prohibited. 
In  the  spirit  of  these  regulations,  marriage 
was  also  forbidden. 

6.  Besides  these  restrictions  and  rules  of 
a  negative  character,  there  were  certain 
positive  requirements  with  which  the  peni- 
tents were  expected  to  comply. 

They  were  obliged  to  be  present,  and  to 
perform  their  part,  at  every  religious  as- 
sembly, whether  public  or  private  ;  a  regu- 
lation which  neither  believers  nor  catechu- 
mens were  required  to  observe. 

They  were  expected  to  abound  in  deeds 
of  charity  and  benevolence,  particularly  in 
almsgiving  to  the  poor. 

Especially  were  they  to  perform  the  du- 
ties of  the  parabolani,  in  giving  attendance 
upon  the  sick,  and  in  taking  care  of  them. 
These  offices  of  kindness  they  were  ex- 
pected particularly  to  bestow  upon  such  a.'* 
were  affected  with  contagious  diseases. 

It  was  also  their  duty  to  assist  at  the 
burial  of  the  dead.  The  regulations  last 
mentioned  are  supjMsed  to  have  been  pecu- 
liar to  the  Church  of  Africa. 

These  duties  and  regulations  collectively 
were  sometimes  included  under  the  general 
term  i^ofioXoyrp-is,  confession.  By  this  was 
understood  not  only  words,  but  works; 
both,  in  connexion,  being  the  appropriate 
means  of  manifesting  sorrow  for  sin,  and  the 
purpose  of  amendment. 

II.  There  are,  in  the  Eoman  Church, 
several  fraternities  (as  they  are  called)  of 
penitents,  distinguished  by  the  different 
shape  and  colour  of  their  habits.  These  are 
secular  societies,  who  have  their,  rules,  sta- 
tutes, and  churches  ;  and  make  public  pro- 
cessions   under    their    particular    cross  or 


PENTATEUCH 

banner.  Of  these  tliere  are  more  tlian  a 
hundred ;  the  most  considerahle  of  which 
are: — 

1.  White  Peaitents.  These  are  of  dif- 
ferent sorts  at  Rome.  The  most  ancient  is 
that  of  Gonfalon,  instituted  in  1264,  in  the 
church  of  St.  Mary  Major :  in  imitation  of 
which  four  others  were  established  in  the 
church  of  Ara-Coeli ;  the  first  under  the 
title  of  the  Nativity  of  our  Lord;  the 
second  under  the  invocation  of  the  Holy 
Virgin;  the  third  under  the  protection  of 
the  Holy  Inno9ents ;  and  the  fourth  under 
the  patronage  of  St.  Helena.  The  brethren 
of  this  fraternity,  every  year,  give  portions 
to  a  certain  mmiber  of  young  girls,  in  order 
to  their  being  married.  Their  habit  is  a 
kind  of  white  sackcloth,  and  on  the  shoul- 
der is  a  circle,  in  the  middle  of  which  is  a 
red  and  white  cross. 

2.  Black  Penitents.  The  most  consider- 
able of  these  are  the  Brethren  of  Mercy,  or 
St.  John  Baptist.  This  fraternity  was  in- 
stituted in  1488,  by  some  Florentines,  in 
order,  to  assist  criminals  at  the  time  of  their 
•death  and  during  their  imprisonment.  On 
the  day  of  execution,  they  walk  in  proces- 
sion before  them,  singing  the  seven  Peniten- 
tial Psalms,  and  the  Litanies;  and,  after 
they  are  dead,  they  take  them  down  from 
the  gibbet,  and  bury  them.  Their  habit 
is  black  sackcloth.  There  are  others  whose 
business  is  to  bury  such  persons  as  are  found 
dead  in  the  streets.  They  wear  a  death's 
head  on  one  side  of  their  habit. 

3.  Blue  Penitents.        -v      All  these  are 

4.  Grey  Penitents.        I  remarkable  only 

5.  Bed  Penitents.  >  for  the  different 

6.  Green  Penitents.      {  colours   of  their 

7.  Violet  Penitents.      •'  habits. 
PENTATEUCH  (17  irfvTaT^vxos  [Pi^^os'] : 

the  Kabbinical title  is  rninn  'Win  nB-pn): 
the  five  books  of  Moses.  It  is  a  matter  of 
question  whether  the  division  of  the  work 
into  five  parts  was  original,  or,  as  is  more  pro- 
bable, made  by  the  Greek  translators.  Also 
whether  the  whole  was  written  by  Moses. 
With  regard  to  the  latter,  the  following  are 
the  conclusions  arrived  at  by  Dean  Perowne 
(Diet,  of  Bible) : — (i.)  The  book  of  Genesis 
depends  on  documents  earlier  than  the  time 
of  Moses,  though  it  was  probably  brought  to 
nearly  its  present  shape  by  Moses,  or  one  of 
the  elders  who  acted  under  him.  (ii.)  Exo- 
dus, Leviticus,  Numbers,  Deuteronomy,  are 
the  work  of  Moses,  with  the  exception, 
perhaps,  of  some  legal  sections,  and  the  con- 
cluding part  of  Deuteronomy,  (iii.)  The 
whole  work  did  not  finally  assume  its  pre- 
sent shape  till  its  revision  was  undertaken  by 
Ezra,  after  the  return  from  the  Babylonish 
captivity. 

The  Samaritan  Pentateuch,  discovered 
and  brought  to  England  in  the  17th  cen- 


PERPENDICULAR 


577 


tury,  by  the  instrumentality  of  Archbishop 
Ussher  and  others,  is  the  Hebrew  Pentateuch 
written  in  the  ancient  Hebrew  letters.  It 
is  supposed  by  many  critic?  to  be  the  actual 
te.'ct  of  the  Scriptures  used  by  the  Samari- 
tans, when  at  their  petition,  Shalmaneser, 
king  of  Assyria,  appointed  one  of  the  Jewish 
priests  to  dwell  at  Bethel  and  teach  them 
how  they  should  fear  the  Lord  (2  Kings 
xvii.  28).  The  copy  of  the  Scriptures  then 
said  to  be  brought  by  this  priest,  contained 
the  canon  of  Scripture,  as  it  then  existed  ; 
and  the  Samaritans  never  recognised  any 
other.  By  several  critics  the  text  is  sup- 
posed more  correct  than  the  Hebrew;  and 
as  an  element  of  biblical  criticism  it  is  in- 
valuable. See  the  article  on  the  Pentateuch 
in  Aids  to  Faith,  by  Canon  Eawlinson. 

PENTECOST  (Prom  nej/rrjKooT-^,  the 
fiftieth).  A  solemn  festival  of  the  Jews,  so 
called  because  it  was  celebrated  fifty  days 
after  the  feast  of  the  Passover  (Lev.  xxiii. 
15,  16).  It  corresponds  with  the  Christian 
Whitsuntide,  which  is  sometimes  called  by 
the  same  name  (See  Whitsuntide). 

PBNTECOSTALS.  These  were  obla- 
tions made  by  the  parishioners  to  their 
priest  at  the  feast  of  Pentecost,  which  are 
sometimes  called  Whitsun-farthings ;  but 
they  were  not  at  first  offered  to  their 
priests,  but  to  their  mother-church ;  and 
this  may  be  the  reason  that  the  deans  and 
prebendaries  in  some  cathedrals  are  entitled 
to  receive  these  oblations,  and  in  some 
places  the  bishop  and  archdeacons,  as  at 
GrloiiC6st6r 

PERAJIBULATIONS  (See  Bounds, 
Beating  of;  Gang  Days  ;  Bogation  Days). 

PERNOCTATJONS.  Watching  all 
night, — long  a  custom  with  the  more  pious 
Christians,    especially    before    the    greater 

PERPENDICULAR.  The  last  style  of 
pure  Gothic  architecture,  which  succeeded 
the  Decorated  about  1380.  It  is  most 
readily  distinguished  by  its  upright  win- 
dow tracery  (see  Tracery);  but  the  four- 
centred  arch  (see  Arch)  is  a  more  important 
feature,  though  by  no  means  invariably 
found  in  this  style.  Its  general  char- 
acteristics are  the  prevalence  of  vertical 
lines  carried  up  and  down  as  far  as  pos- 
sible ;  the  disappearance  of  the  triforium  in 
cathedrals,  and  of  curved  patterns  in  the 
window  tracery,  except  the  repetition  of  a 
few  arches;  the  absence  or  smallness  of 
carved  or  even  moulded  caps  to  pillars,  the 
arches  often  rising  from  them,  without 
any  "  oversailing  "  or  projection ;  and  above 
all  a  general  monotony  and  repetition  of 
exactly  similar  details.  High  roofs  were 
often  degraded  into  nearly  flat  ones  in 
Perpendicular  times,  and  the  clearstories 
became  higher  and  more  filled  with  painted 

2  p 


S78 


PEEPETUA 


glass.  The  oue  great  addition  to  previous 
construction  was  the  Ijcautiful  fan  tracery- 
roofs,  whicli  every  one  who  has  seen  under- 
stands the  look  of,  and  no  explanation 
would  suffice.  The  great  examples  of  it  are 
King's  College  Chapel,  289  feet  long  and 
48  wide,  Bath  Ablx;y  and  Iledcliffe  Church, 
and  the  eastern  aisle  behind  the  apse  of 
Peterborough.  St.  George's,  Windsor,  and 
Henry  VII.'s  Chayn;!  at  Westminster  are 
later  and  baser  fonns,  encumbered  with 
"  pendants  "  which  arc  all  false  construction. 
,  That  was  the  last  phase  of  architecture  that 
could  be  called  Gothic,  or  a  genuine  arc- 
uated style  at  all,  and  it  died  out  in  the 
reign  of  Henry  VIII.  There  are  many  fine 
Perpendicular  towerfl  however,  and  one  very 
grand  spired  tower,  that  of  Louth.  St. 
Michael's,  Coventry,  is  higher,  but  much 
too  narrow,  and  yet  is  going  to  he  rebuUt 
so,  as  the  tower  of  Manchester  Cathedral 
was  about  twenty  years  ago,  and  now  they 
repent  of  it  (See  Caxiitah,  IHllar,  Moulding, 
Vaulting).     [G.] 

PERPETUA.  Martyr.  A  Carthagmian 
matron  of  good  family  who  suffered  in  the 
persecution  by  Sovorus  about  a.d.  203  in 
Africa.  She  was,  with  Felicitas  and  three 
companions,  condemned  to  the  punishment 
of  the  wild  beasts,  that  is  to  say,  placed  in 
the  arena  to  be  worried  to  death.  She  was 
tossed  by  a  wild  cow,  and  afterwards  slowly 
butchered  by  a  timorous  executioner.  The 
"  Acts  of  St.  Perpetua"  are  supposed  to  have 
been  partly  vrritten  by  herself,  and  com- 
pleted by  TertuUian.  She  is  commemorated 
on  March  7. — Diet.  Cliriat.  Biog.    [H.] 

PERPETUAL  CURATE.  The  incum- 
bent of  a  church,  cliapol,  or  district,  which 
is  within  the  boundaries  of  a  rectory  or 
vicarage ;  so  called  in  distinction  to  a  curate 
assistant,  whose  office  expires  with  the  in- 
cumbency of  the  person  who  employs  him, 
or  at  any  time  by  the  concurrence  of  the 
incumbent  and  the  bishop.  They  have 
almost  ceased  to  exist  by  the  Act  31  &  32 
Vict.  c.  117,  which  made  them  aU  into 
vicars,  when  their  churches  were  authorised 
for  holding  marriages. 

PEBPETUALS.  TVenty  ministers  of 
the  choir  at  Lyons,  so  called  from  being 
bound  to  perpetual  service  there.  This 
office  resembles  that  of  tlio  vicars  choral  in 
our  cathedrals. 

PERSECUTION.  I.  In  the  first  three 
centuries  of  the  Christian  era,  the  believers 
were  subjected  to  terrible  persecutions. 
These  began  in  the  earliest  times.  The 
Sanhedrim  countenanced  the  martyrdom  of 
St.  Stephen,  and  "haled  men  and  women 
to  prison  "  (Acts  viii.  3).  Herod,  seeing  it 
pleased  the  Jews,  persecuted  the  Christians, 
and  "killed  James  the  brother  of  John 
with    the    sword"    (Acts    xii.    2).      Per- 


PEESECUTION 

secution  of  a  more  general  and  authorised 
kind  began  about  the  time  when  St.  Peter 
wrote  his  second  epistle,  and  St.  Paul  his- 
second  epistle  to  Timothy  (2  St.  Pet.  i.  24 ; 
2  Tim.  i.  8  :  ii.  9  :  iv.  6-8).  In  these 
epistles  prophetic  reference  is  made  to  their 
coming  martyrdoms,  which  took  place  about 
A.D.  67 ;  and  from  that  time  till  A.D.  324 
the  blood  of  Christians  "  flowed  like  water." 
Tacitus  gives  an  account  of  the  sufferings  of 
the  Christians  under  Nero,  who  charged 
them  with  the  conflagration  of  Rome,  of 
which  he  himself  was  the  author.  The 
Christians  were  supposed  to  be  haters  of 
mankind;  so  "their  sufferings  were  ag- 
gravated by  insult  and  mockery.  Some 
were  disguised  in  the  skins  of  wild  beasts 
and  worried  to  death  by  dogs ;  others  were 
wrapped  in  tarred  shirts,  and  set  on  fire  that 
they  might  illuminate,  as  lights,  the  em- 
peror's garden  in  the  night."  Tacitus 
confesses  that  this  inhuman  conduct  made 
the  sufferers  pitied,  as  "  they  were  sacrificed^ 
not  for  the  public  good,  but  to  gratify  the 
cruelty  of  the  man"  (^Annals,  xv.  24). 
Juvenal  also  refers  to  the  sufferings  of  the- 
Christians  (Sat.  i.  155) : 

Qui  stantes  ardent  et  fixo  gutture  fumant. 

And  Seneca  speaks  of  the  torments  in- 
flicted, mentioning  "  a  stake  thrust  through 
the  body  and  coming  out  at  the  mouth  (im- 
palement), and  the  limbs  torn  by  chariots 
pulling  diverse  ways  .  .  .  and  whatever- 
else  cruelty  has  invented"  (Sen.  Ep.  14). 
The  persecutions  of  the  Christians  by 
the  Romans  have  been  accounted  ten  in 
number.  But  the  ancient  history  of  the 
Chixrch  does  not  support  precisely  this 
number ;  for  if  we  reckon  only  the  general 
and  more  severe  persecutions,  there  were 
fewer:  if  the  provincial  and  more  limited 
persecutions,  there  were  more  than  ten. 
The  principal  were  those  under  Nero,  a.d. 
64-68  (martyrdom  of  SS.  Peter  and  Paul,, 
exile  of  St.  John) ;  under  Domitian,  95,  96 ; 
under  Trajan,  104-117  (martyrdom  of  St. 
Ignatius) ;  under  Hadrian,  125-138 ;  \mder 
M.  Aurelius  (the  favourite  phUosophieal 
emperor  of  the  modem  infidels),  161-180 
(martyrdom  of  St.  Polycarp,  and  the  martyrs 
of  Lyons) ;  under  Severus,  200-211  (mar- 
tyrdom of  St.  Perpetua,  and  many  in  Africa) ; 
under  Maximinus  (partial),  235-237  ;  under 
Decius,  250-253  ;  under  Valerian,  257-260. 
(martyrdom  of  St.  Cyprian) ;  under  Dio- 
cletian and  Galerius,  in  which  the  English 
protomartyr,  Alban,  fell,  303-313. — Gibbon,. 
Bed.  and  Fall,  c.  xvi. ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim, 
cent.  1 ;  Bishop  Steere's  Account  of  the 
Persecutions,  &c. ;  Blunt's  History  of  First' 
Three  Centuries.     [H.] 

II.  The  persecutions  by  Papal  Rome  after 
the  first  symptoms  of  the  Reformation  en- 


PEESEVERAKCE 

ormously  exceeded  in  magnitude  those  of 
Pagan  Rome.  Tliey  were  generally  carried 
on  by  the  help  of  the  State,  all  over  Euroi^e, 
except  in  Russia,  which  supports  the  Greek 
Church,  and  not  without  persecution.  The 
Marian  persecution  in  England  did  more  to 
establish  the  Eeformation  as  soon  as  she  and 
Cardinal  Pole  were  dead  (on  the  same  day) 
than  would  ever  have  been  done  without  it 
(See  Reformation).  The  Roman  Church 
has  never  revoked  its  declarations  that 
heresy  ought  to  be  put  down  by  force.  The 
Inquisition  was  its  most  formidable  instru- 
ment, but  was  never  estabUshed  here  or  in 
France,  as  it  was  in  many  other  countries. 
But  persecution  prevailed  in  France  with- 
out it.  That  acted  without  the  direct  aid 
of  the  State.  Sundry  histories  of  it  have 
been  written  by  Leinborch  and  others. 

III.  It  cannot  be  denied  that  persecution 
up  to  death  for  religious  opinion  lasted 
more  or  less  after  the  Eeformation,  especially 
under  Henry  VIII.  But  in  the  time  of 
Elizabeth  popery  was  so  mixed  up  with 
rebellion  and  plots  against  her  fostered  by 
the  pope,  that  what  was  in  one  sense  perse- 
cution was  really  defence  of  the  existing 
dynasty.  Popish  persecution  was  resumed 
under  James  II.,  and  the  proceedings  of  the 
papists  then  and  afterwards  in  Ireland  led 
to  severe  penal  laws  against  them.  The 
puritans  also  persecuted  their  opponents  in 
property  Lf  not  in  person ;  and  the  continued 
robbery  of  the  Church  in  Prance  by  the 
present  government  and  parliament  of  that 
country,  and  the  murders  of  several  succes- 
sive archbishops  by  the  mob  shows  that 
Christianity  may  again  have  to  endure  per- 
secution from  unbelievers;  and  so  do  some 
of  their  proceedings  and  attempts  to  pre- 
vent religious  education  here.     [G.] 

PEESEVERANCB,  FINAL.  According 
to  the  Calvinistic  system,  the  elect  receive 
the  grace  of  perseverance,  so  that  when 
grace  has  once  been  received,  they  cannot 
finally  fall  from  it.  This  follows  from 
their  view  of  election.  But,  according  to 
the  Catholic  view  of  grace  and  of  election, 
men  may  fall,  and  fell  finally,  from  the 
grace  they  have  once  received  (See  the 
article  on  Election,  of  which  this  may  be 
considered  a  continuation).  Since  the 
Reformed  Church  of  England  (with  the 
primitive  and  Catholic)  regards  election  as 
an  admission  into  the  pale  of  the  visible 
Church  Catholic,  not  a  necessary  and  in- 
fallible admission  into  eternal  glory,  she 
obviously  could  not  teach  the  doctrine  of 
the  assured  final  perseverance  of  every 
individual  among  the  elect ;  but,  annexing 
a  totally  different  sense  to  the  word  elect 
itself  from  that  which  is  jointly  advocated 
by  Calvin  and  by  Arminius,  she  consis- 
tently pronounces  that  the  elect,  ag  she 


PERSEVERANCE 


579 


imderstands  the  term,  may  finally  fall 
away,  and  thence  may  everlastingly  perish. 
To  this  moral  possibility  of  final  apostasy 
the  Anglican  Church,  as  was  felt  by  the 
Calvinistic  party  in  the  conference  at 
Hampton  Court,  alludes,  though  she  does 
not  specifically  there  define  the  matter,  in 
her  sixteenth  Article. 

"  After  we  have  received  the  Holy  Ghost, 
we  [may  depart  from  grace  given,  and  fall 
into  sin ;  and  by  the  grace  of  God  we  may 
arise  again,  and  amend  our  lives." 

Here  it  seems  to  be  not  obscurely  inti- 
mated, that  the  elect,  even  after  they  have 
received  the  Holy  Ghost,  may  so  depart 
from  grace  given,  and  may  so  fall  into  sin, 
that  they  either  may,  or  may  not,  be  re- 
stored by  the  influential  grace  of  God. 

Such,  accordingly,  was  doubtless  per- 
ceived to  be  the  case  by  the  Calvinistic 
party;  for  otherwise  it  is  impossible  to 
account  for  their  proposed  alteration  of  the 
article,  which  would  have  made  it  speak 
the  language  of  assured  personal  final  per- 
severance. 

They  moved  King  James,  that,  to  the 
original  words  of  the  article,  "  after  we  have 
received  the  Holy  Ghost,  we  may  depart 
from  grace  given,  and  fall  into  sin,"  might 
be  subjoined  the  following  explanatory 
addition,  "  yet  neither  totally  nor  finally." 

Had  this  addition  been  made,  the  seven- 
teenth Article  would  doubtless  have  taught 
the  d.octrine  of  the  final  perseverance  of  all 
the  elect.  The  wish  to  make  it  do  so 
imported  a  consciousness  that  the  reformed 
Anglican  Church  held  no  such  doctrine. 

Nor  was  this  consciousness  ill-founded. 
The  homily  on  "  Falling  from  God,"  as  we 
might  anticipate  from  its  very  title,  dis- 
tinctly asserts,  in  both  its  parts,  the  moral 
possibility,  in  the  elect,  of  finally  departing 
from  grace  given,  and  of  thus  perishing 
everlastingly. 

The  doctrine  of  the  possibility  of  the 
elect  finally  falhng  away,  says  Faber  in  his 
work  on  "Election,"  from  grace  to  per- 
dition; a  doctrine  which,  in  truth,  is 
nothing  more  than  the  inevitable  and  ne- 
cessary result  of  that  ideality  of  election, 
which,  from  primitive  antiquity,  has  been 
adopted  by  the  Anglican  Church,  is  very 
distinctly  and  very  affectingly  propounded 
also  in  her  admirable  and  sublime  burial 
service. 

"  Spare  us,  Lord  most  holy,  0  God  most 
mighty,  0  holy  and  merciful  Saviour,  thou 
most  worthy  Judge  eternal,  suffer  us  not, 
at  our  last  hour,  for  any  pains  of  death,  to 
fall  from  thee." 

The  prayer  before  us  is  couched  in  the 
plural  form,  and  the  persons  who  are 
directed  concurrently  with  the  officiating 
minister  to  use  it,  are  those  identical  per- 

2  P  2 


580 


PERSON 


sous  who,  having  been  chosen  in  the  course 
of  Divine  providence,  and  brought  by  bap- 
tism into  the  pale  of  the  visible  Church, 
have  thence  been  declared  to  be  the  elect 
people  of  God. 

Consequently  those  who,  in  the  judgment 
of  the  Church  of  England,  are  the  elect 
people  of  God,  are  nevertheless  directed  to 
pray,  that  the  I^ord  would  not  suffer  them, 
at  their  last  hour,  for  any  pains  of  death,  to 
fall  from  Him. 

Hence,  as  the  English  Church  under- 
stands the  term  elect,  it  is  possible,  from 
the  very  necessity  of  such  a  prayer,  that 
those  who  are  elect  may  not  only  for  a 
season  fall  away  from  God  and  be  afterward 
renewed  by  repentance,  but  may  even  fall 
away  from  Him  totally  and  finally. 

PERSON  (See  Trinity).  The  word 
"  person  "  as  applied  to  our  Blessed  Lord  is 
used  by  St.  Paul,  2  Cor.  ii.  10,  and  iv.  6. 
Here  the  Greek  word  is  irpoa-aiTov.  In 
the  Epistle  to  the  Hebrews,  in  the  author- 
ised version,  the  word  "  person  "  is  applied 
to  God  the  Father,  but  here  the  Greek  word 
is  xmooTacris,  which  has  quite  a  different 
meaning.  In  the  apostolic  times  such  dis- 
tinctions were  not  dwelt  upon,  and  the 
personality  in  the  Trinity  does  not  seem  to 
have  been  questioned.  B  ut  afterwards  there 
were  many  controversies  on  this  subject, 
and  there  was  much  misunderstanding  be- 
cause of  the  confusion  between  the  Greek 
and  Latin  terms.  It  was  necessary,  because 
of  the  heresies  which  arose  with  regard  to 
the  Trinity,  to  make  definite  statements  of 
the  Christian  doctrine.  TertuUian  had 
written  "videmus  duplicem  statum  non 
confusum  sed  conjunctum  in  una  persona 
Deum  et  Hominem  Jesum  "  (_Adv.  Praxem, 
xxviii.).  But  the  Monarchians  denied  that 
there  was  one  Person  of  the  Father,  another 
of  the  Son,  and  another  of  the  Holy  Ghost ; 
admitting  the  Unity,  they  denied  the 
Trinity.  The  SabeUians  maintained  that 
God  was  one  Person,  and  that  the  Father, 
Son,  and  Holy  Ghost  are  one  and  the  same 
Person ;  thus,  in  the  language  of  the  Atha- 
nasian  Creed,  "confounding  the  Persons" 
(See  Sabdlians;  Monarchians).  These 
heresies  were  repudiated  at  the  Council  of 
Nicsea,  and  afterwards  in  the  Athanasian 
Creed— "The  Catholic  faith  is  this,  Tiiat 
we  worship  One  God  in  Trinity,  and  Trinity 
in  Unity ;  neither  confounding  the  Persons, 
nor  dividing  the  substance.  For  there  is 
one  Person  of  the  Father,  another  of  the 
Son,  and  another  of  the  Holy  Ghost.  But 
the  Godhead  of  the  Father,  of  the  Son,  and 
of  the  Holy  Ghost,  is  all  one :  the  glory 
equal,  the  majesty  co-eternal." 

It  ia  important  to  observe  that  many  later 
controversies  rest  on  a  misconception  of 
terms.    "  Persona,"  in  Latin,  bore  the  same 


PESHITO 

relation  to  "substantia"  as  viroaraa-K  to 
oitria;  but  {nroa-Taa-ts,  in  the  sense  of 
person,  was  the  exact  equivalent  for  the 
very  different  theological  idea  of  "sub- 
stantia" in  Latin.  Prom  this  arose  the 
confusion  of  ideas  with  regard  to  the  word. 
Hilary  coined  the  term  "essentia,"  to 
convey  the  meaning  of  oi<ria,  of  which 
St.  Augustine  says,  "  Novo  quidem  nomine, 
quo  usi  non  sunt  veteres  Latini  auctores, 
sed  jam  nostris  temporibus  usitato,  ne  deesset 
etiam  nostrse  linguce  quod  Grasci  appellant 
■  ova-lav ' "     (Giv.  D.  xii.  ii.). 

The  Latin  Church  understanding  "sub- 
stance "  by  the  term  hypostasis,  as  used 
by  the  Greek  Church,  and  denying  three 
substances,  would  not  readily  use  that  term, 
but  adopted  the  word  "Person"  (Persona) 
to  characterize  the  three  distinct  subsisten- 
cies  in  the  one  Divine  essence.  And  hence 
has  arisen  a  charge  (the  word  hypostasis 
being  used  for  Person  in  the  Greek  copies 
of  the  Creed)  that  the  Nicene  and  Athana- 
sian Creeds  are  in  opposition  to  each  other ; 
the  former  asserting  that  the  Son  "is  of  one 
substance  with  the  Father,"  while,  according 
to  the  latter,  there  is  one  substance  of  the 
Father,  another  of  the  Son,  &o.  But  as  the 
word  is  rightly  translated  in  our  version 
"Person,"  from  the  original  Latin,  the 
objection,  which  is  still  repeated  (the  passage 
being  quoted  as  if  it  were  one  "  substance  " — 
not  one  "  Person — of  the  Father,"  &c.),  is 
persevered  in  under  a  mistake,  if  it  be  not 
a  wilful  misrepresentation.  — ■  Waterland ; 
Bishop  Bull,  Def.  Fid.  Nic.  Works,  v.  311 
seq. ;  Mansell,  Limits  of  Eeligious  Thoiight, 
56 ;  Blunt's  Diet.  Tlieol. 

PERSONA  (See  Parson).  A  term  ap- 
phed  in  ancient  cathedral  and  collegiate 
statutes  to  those  who  held  particular  oifices, 
not  necessarily  of  dignity,  or  of  jurisdiction, 
but  involving  personal  responsibility,  and 
strict  residence.  In  England,  at  Salisbury 
and  other  cathedrals  of  the  old  foundation, 
the  dignitaries,  as  the  dean,  precentor,  chan- 
cellor, and  treasurer,  &c.,  were  called 
Personss  Principales,  or  Privilegiatm,  as 
having  each  a  peculiar  ofiBoe,  connected  with 
the  service  of  the  church.  At  St.  Paul's 
the  four  archdeacons  were  included  in  this 
title,  though  somewhat  incorrectly. — Dug- 
dale's  St.  PauVs,  p.  235.  By  the  Hereford 
Statutes  the  bishop,  dean,  precentor,  trea- 
surer and  chancellor  are  "  personje  in  digni- 
tatibus  constitutse."  In  other  places,  as  at 
York  and  Beverley,  the  chantry  priests 
were  called  personse.  In  foreign  churches 
the  inferior  cathedral  clergy  are  called 
"  personats." 

PESHITO  (simple),  the  Arameean  version 
of  the  Scriptures,  assigned  almost  uni- 
versally to  the  most  remote  Christian  anti- 
quity.   There  is  no  doubt  that  the  so-called 


PETEE-PENCE 

Syro-Chaldaic — that  is,  the  Aiama3an — was 
the  Yernacular  language  of  the  Jews  of 
Palestine  in  the  time  of  our  Lord,  however 
much  it  may  have  been  superseded  by  Greek 
in  the  common  business  of  life.  It  was  in 
this  dialect,  the  "Hebrew"  of  the  New  Testa- 
ment, that  the  Gospel  of  St.  Matthew  was 
originally  written,  according  to  the  unani- 
mous testimony  of  the  Fathers  (but  see  ar- 
ticle on  St.  Matthew's  Gospel).  The  Peshito 
comprises  all  the  canonical  boolis  of  the 
Old  Testament,  but  not  the  Apocrypha, 
which,  exist  in  a  separate  version  as  used  by 
Ephrem  Syrus.  Gregory  Bar  Hebrseus,  one 
of  the  most  learned  of  Syrian  writers,  relates 
that  the  New  Testament  Peshito  "was 
made  in  the  time  of  Thaddeus  and  Abgarus, 
king  of  Edessa,"  when  the  Apostle  went 
to  preach  in  Mesopotamia,  and  this  state- 
ment he  repeats  several  times.  He  assumes 
the  apostolic  origin  of  the  New  Testament 
Peshito  as  certain;  for  while  he  gives 
three  hypotheses  "as  to  the  date  of  the 
Old  Testament  version,  he  speaks  of  this  as 
a  known  and  acknowledged  fact  (Card. 
Wiseman,  Eor.  Syr.  131,  236).  The  version 
exists  at  present  in  two  distinct  classes  of 
manuscripts.  Some  are  written  in  the 
ancient  Syriac  letters,  and  others  of  Indian 
origin  in  the  iSTestorian  character.  These 
present  variations  from  the  common  text, 
but  they  coincide  as  far  as  the  canon  is 
concerned.  Both  omit  the  second  and  third 
Epistles  of  St.  John,  the  second  Epistle  of  St. 
Peter,  the  Epistle  of  St.  Jude  and  the  Apoca- 
lypse, but  include  all  the  other  books  as  com- 
monly received  withoutanyaddition. —  Canon 
of  the  New  Test,  Westcott,  p.  204,  &c.  [H.] 
PETER-PENCE  was  an  annual  tribute 
of  lone  penny,  paid  at  Home  out  of  every 
family,  at  the  feast  of  St.  Peter.  This,  Ina, 
the  Saxon  king,  when  he  went  in  pilgrimage 
to  Rome,  about  the  year  740,  gave  to  the 
pope,  partly  as  alms,  and  partly  by  way  of 
recompense  for  a  house  erected  in  Rome  for 
English  pilgrims.  It  continued  to  be  gen- 
erally paid,  not  as  a  due,  but  as  a  benefaction 
until  the  time  of  King  Henry  VIII.,  when 
it  was  enacted,  that  henceforth  no  person 
shaU  pay  any  pensions,  Peter-pence,  or 
other  impositions,  to  the  use  of  the  bishop 
and  see  of  Rome. 

PETER'S,  ST.,  DAY.  A  festival  of  the 
Christian  Church,  observed  on  the  twenty- 
ninth  of  June. 

St.  Peter,  who  by  trade  was  a  fisherman, 
was  born  at  Bethsaida,  a  town  situated  upon 
the  banks  of  the  sea  of  Galilee.  He  was 
originally  called  Simon,  or  Simeon,  to  which 
our  Saviour,  after  his  call,  added  the  name 
of  Cephas  (t<Q'3),  an  Aramaic  word,  of 
wMch  tbe  equivalent  in  Greek  is  Ile'rpor 
(Petrus,  Rock).  Our  Lord  probably  intended 
by  this    appellation  to    denote    the    con- 


PBTER'S,  ST.,  DAY 


581 


stancy  and  finnness  of  his  faith,  and  his 
activity  in  working  for  the  substantiation  of 
the  Church.  It  is  evident  that  the  other 
disciples  looked  to  him  aa  a  leader  under 
Christ,  and  the  self-confidence  which  he 
displayed  was  punished  by  his  fall  into  the 
sin  of  denying  our  Lord.  After  that  lapse, 
over  which  he  wept  bitterly,  he  lived  a  hfe 
of  penitence ;  but  he  was  always  a  leading 
spirit,  and  by  some  early  writers  he  is  called 
the  mouth  of  the  apostles,  because  he  was 
the  first  and  forwardest,  on  all  occasions,  to 
profess  his  zeal  and  attachment  to  our 
Saviour.  But  it  does  not  appear  that  our 
Saviour  gave  any  personal  prerogative  to  St. 
Peter,  as  universal  pastor  and  head  of  the 
Church ;  and  much  less  to  any  bishops 
claiming  to  be  his  successors.  He  is  placed 
first  among  the  apostles,  because  he,  with 
St.  Andrew,  his  brother,  was  first  called. 
If  he  is  styled  "a  rock,"  all  the  apostles 
are  equally  styled  "  foundations  " ;  and  the 
"  power  of  the  keys  "  is  promised  to  the  rest 
of  the  apostles  as  well  aa  to  St.  Peter. 

St.  Peter's  first  mission,  after  our  Saviour's 
ascension,  was  to  those  Christians  whom 
Philip  the  deacon  had  converted  in  Samaria ; 
where  he  conferred  on  them  the  gift  of  the 
Holy  Ghost,  and  severely  rebuked  Simon 
Magus  for  imagining  that  the  gift  of  God 
could  be  purchased  with  money.  Some 
time  after,  he  had  a  special  vision  from 
heaven,  by  which  the  Divine  goodness  re- 
moved those  prejudices  of  his  education 
which  the  Jews  had  entertained  against  the 
Gentiles.  In  the  dispute  between  the 
Jewish  and  Gentile  converts,  he  declared 
God's  acceptance  of  the  Gentiles,  and  that 
the  yoke  of  the  Jewish  rites  ought  not  to  be 
laid  upon  them.  Yet  afterwards  he  dis- 
sembled his  Christian  liberty,  and  thereby 
confirmed  the  judaizing  Christians  in  their 
errors ;  for  which  he  was  rebuked  by  St. 
Paul  (Gal.  ii.  11). 

St.  Peter  afterwards  preached  at  Antioch, 
of  which  place  it  is  said  he  was  the  first 
bishop  (Origen,  Ham.  vi.  in  Luc.}.  He  is  also 
claimed  as  the  first  bishop  of  Rome.  That 
he  consecrated  bishops  for  those  places  is 
most  probable,  but  it  may  be  considered  as 
a  settled  point  that  he  did  not  visit  Rome 
before  the  last  year  of  his  life.  Into  the 
controversies  with  regard  to  St.  Peter's  work 
it  is  not  possible  here  to  enter  ;  but  a  full 
account  may  be  found  in  the  Dictionary  of 
the  BiUe  (p.  803). 

According  to  tradition  St.  Peter  suffered 
martyrdom  about  the  year  of  Christ  69,  under 
the  emperor  Nero,  whom  he  had  provoked  by 
his  success  against  Simon  Magus,  and  by  his 
reducing  many  dissolute  women  to  a  sober 
and  virtuous  life ;  and  it  was  probably  in  that 
persecution  when  the  emperor  burnt  Rome, 
and  charged  the  Christians  with  the  guilt 


582 


PEW 


and  punishment  of  it.  He  was  crucified 
■with  his  head  downwards.  It  is  said,  his 
body  was  embalmed  by  Marcellinus  the 
presbyter,  and  buried  in  the  Vatican,  near 
the  Triumphal  way,  where  there  was  a, 
church  erected  to  his  memory,  now  the 
famous  cathedral  of  St.  Peter's  at  Eome. 

PEW.  The  word  is  derived  from  the 
Latin  podium,  Greek  ttoSIov,  literally  a  foot- 
stool ;  whence  it  came  to  mean  a  balcony, 
gallery,  or  any  space  enclosed  with  a  railing 
to  lean  upon.  Pews  are  or  were  till  lately 
generally  understood  to  mean  enclosed  seats 
or  boxes,  of  which  certain  persons  claim  to  be 
either  owners  or  lessees.  They  can  only  be  so  in 
new  churches  built  under  58  Geo.  III.  c.  45, 
and  some  of  the  Acts  which  allow  pews  or 
seats  to  be  sold  or  let,  or  in  old  churches  by 
prescription  or  long  usage  accompanied  by 
repairing  whenever  they  have  needed  it. 
A  single  instance  of  repairing  by  the  parish, 
except  under  special  agreement,  is  generally 
fatal  to  a  claim  of  prescription.  But  the 
word  "  pew  "  is  often  used  also  of  a  whole 
bench  or  seat  as  a  piece  of  construction, 
though  not  enclosed  by  a  door  or  claimed 
by  any  owner  or  lessee.  In  old  parish 
churches  there  can  be  no  lawful  letting  of 
seats  or  pews,  except  where  there  is  owner- 
ship by  prescription,  or  a  faculty ;  but  a 
faculty  only  gives  the  right  to  a  man  and 
his  heirs  living  in  the  parish  to  sit  there,  and 
does  not  affect  the  actual  ownership,  which  is 
in  the  parson  in  trust  for  the  parish,  or  the 
owner  of  the  faculty.  A  pew  in  the  body 
of  the  church  (and  a  fortiori  in  a  separate 
aisle  or  chapel)  may  be  prescribed  for  as 
appurtenant  to  a  house  even  out  of  the 
parish. — Lousley  v.  Eayward,  1  Y.  &  J.  583. 
By  the  various  Church-building  Acts  from 
one  fifth  to  one  half  of  the  seats  must 
generally  be  left  free,  and  all  the  rest  may  be 
treated  in  almost  any  way  that  is  agreed  on 
beforehand,  or  allotted  to  subscribers  to  the 
building,  or  left,  or  afterwards  surrendered 
to  be  dealt  with  by  the  churchwardens  and 
the  ordinary  as  in  old  churches.  It  is 
impossible  to  refer  to  all  the  Acts  here,  or 
aU  their  separate  provisions.  But  it  has 
oecome  necessary  to  explain  that  the  word 
"  free  "  in  those  Acts  is  always  used  in  con- 
tradistinction to  "rented,"  and  never  in 
the  sense  of  "  free  and  unassignable  from 
time  to  time  by  churchwardens,"  with 
an  appeal  to  the  Ordinary. 

The  square  pews  which  were  in  fashion 
during  the  two  last  centuries  and  the  early 
part  of  this  are  so  fast  disappearing,  that  it 
is  just  worth  while  to  describe  them  as  they 
often  were.  They  presented  all  degrees  of 
luxury  and  discomfort,  from  a  mere  square 
box  with  seats  all  round  in  which  peojDle's 
feet  met,  up  to  a  small  drawing  room  with 
the  walls  lined  and  cushioned,  and  some- 


PHILIP,  ST. 

times  a  small  stove  in  the  middle,  and  a 
private  door  from  the  churchyard.  They 
frequently  had  curtains  all  round,  besides 
high  partitions,  and  it  was  perfectly  easy  to 
play  at  cards  in  silence,  or  to  eat  luncheon, 
and  a  fortiori  to  read  any  book  you  pleased. 
It  is  immaterial  to  inquire,  and  perhaps 
impossible  to  ascertain,  how  this  system 
grew  up,  except  by  mere  usurpation  and 
acquiescence.  They  had  evidently  begun 
by  the  time  of  Bishop  Wren  of  Hereford 
and  afterwards  of  Ely,  temp.  Car.  I.,  for 
it  seems  that  in  some  visitation  articles 
at  Hereford  he  inquired,  "Are  there  any 
privy  closets  or  close  pews  in  your  church  ? 
Are  any  so  lofty  that  they  hinder  the  pro- 
spect of  this  church  so  that  they  which  be 
in  them  are  hidden  from  the  congregation  ?  " 
which  also  proves  that  they  were  then 
usurpations  which  ought  to  be  put  down, 
as  they  now  have  been  almost  universally, 
except  where  they  are  of  the  nature  of  private 
chapels  or  aisles.  The  notion  of  some 
rectors,  lay  and  clerical,  that  the  seats  in 
the  chancel  and  the  disposition  of  them 
belongs  to  them,  and  not  to  the  church- 
wardens, subject  to  the  ordinary,  is  un- 
founded, beyond  that  the  rector,  and  pro- 
bably his  family,  are  entitled  to  the  chief 
pew  there.  Disturbance  of  a  pew,  i.e.  of 
the  right  of  sitting  there  if  prescription 
is  claimed,  is  triable  at  common  law  and  not 
in  the  ecclesiastical  court.     [G.] 

The  earliest  pew  for  the  use  of  the  con- 
gregation remaining,  whose  age  is  determined 
by  the  appearance  of  a  date,  is  in  the  north 
aisle  of  GeddLngton  St.  Mary,  Northampton- 
shire, and  has  the  following  inscription : 

Churchwardens,     William  Thorn, 

John  Wilkie, 
Minister,  Thomas  Jones,  1602. 

Another  pew  exists  in  the  same  church 
dated  1604. 

PHILIP,  ST.,  AND  ST.  JAMES'S  DAY. 
A  festival  of  the  Christian  Church,  observed 
on  the  first  day  of  May.. 

I.  St.  Philip  was  a  native  of  Bethsaida, 
in  Galilee,  and  probably  a  fisherman,  the 
general  trade  of  that  place.  He  had  the 
honour  of  being  first  called  to  be  a  disciple 
of  our  Blessed  Saviour.  It  was  to  Philip 
our  Saviour  proposed  that  question,  what 
they  should  do  to  procure  so  much  bread  as 
would  feed  the  vast  multitude  that  followed 
him?  It  was  to  him  the  Gtentile  proselytes 
addressed  themselves,  when  desirous  to  see 
Jesus.  And  it  was  with  Philip  our  Lord 
had  that  discourse  concerning  Himself  before 
the  last  supper. 

The  Upper  Asia  fell  to  this  apostle's  lot, 
where  he  took  great  pains  in  planting  the 
gospel,  and  by  his  preaching  and  miracles 
made  many  converts.     In  the  latter  end  of 


PHILIP,  ST. 

fliis  life,  he  came  to  Hierapolis  in  Phrygia, 
a  city  very  much  addicted  to  idolatry,  and 
particularly  to  the  worship  of  a  serpent  or 
dragon  of  prodigious  bigness.  St.  Philip,  so 
the  legend  goes,by  his  prayers,  procured  the 
•death,  or,  at  least,  the  disappearing,  of  this 
monster,  and  convinced  its  worshippers  of 
the  absurdity  of  paying  Divine  honours  to 
such  odious  creatures.  But  the  magistrates, 
enraged  at  Philip's  success,  imprisoned  him 
and  ordered  him  to  be  severely  scourged,  and 
"then  put  to  death ;  which,  some  say,  was 
by  crucifixion ;  others,  by  hanging  him  up 
against  a  pillar. 

St.  PhUip  is  generally  reckoned  among 
the  married  apostles ;  and  it  is  said  he 
had  three  daughtere,  two  whereof  persevered 
an  their  virginity,  and  died  at  Hierapolia; 
the  third,  having  led  a  very  spuitual  Ufe, 
died  at  Ephesus  (Euseb.  v.  24).  But  pro- 
bably there  is  some  confusion  in  this  be- 
tween St.  Philip  the  apostle,  and  Philip  the 
evangelist  (Acts  xxi.  9).  He  left  behind  him 
no  writings.  The  gospel,  under  his  name, 
was  forged  by  the  Gnostics,  to  countenance 
their  bad  principles,  and  worse  practices. 

II.  St.  James  the  Less  is  styled,  in 
Scripture,  our  Lord's  brother ;  and  by 
-Josephus,  eminently  skilful  in  matters  of 
genealogy,  expressly  called  the  brother  of 
-Jesus  Christ  (Ant.  xx.  9) :  by  which  the  an- 
cient Fathers  understand  thathe  was  Joseph's 
son  by  a  former  wife.  He  was  surnamed  the 
Less,  to  distinguish  him  from  the  other  St. 
.James ;  and  that  either  from  the  statm-e  of 
his  body,  or  the  difference  of  his  age.  But 
he  acquired  a  more  honourable  appellation 
from  the  piety  and  virtue  of  his  life ;  which 
was  that  of  St.  James  the  Just,  by  which 
'he  is  still  known. 

After  our  Saviour's  ascension,  St.  James 
•was  chosen  bishop  of  Jerusalem.  St.  Paul, 
after  his  conversion,  addressed  himself  to 
this  apostle,  by  whom  he  was  honoured 
•with  the  right  hand  of  fellowship.  It  was 
to  St.  James  St.  Peter  sent  the  news  of  his 
uniraculous  deliverance  out  of  prison.  As 
bishop  of  Jerusalem  he  presided  over  the 
■Synod  of  Jerusalem,  in  the  great  contro- 
versy concerning  the  Jewish  rites  and  cere- 
monies (Acts  XV.).  He  was  of  a  meek  and 
'humble  disposition.  His  temperance  was 
admirable ;  for  he  wholly  abstained  from  flesh, 
.and  drank  neither  wine  nor  strong  drink,  nor 
ever  used  the  bath.  Prayer  was  his  constant 
'business  and  delight,  and  by  his  daily  de- 
votions his  knees  were  become  as  hard  and 
brawny  as  those  of  a  camel. 

St.  Paul  having  escaped  the  malice  of  the 
•  Jews  by  appealing  to  Csesar,  they  resolved 
to  revenge  it  upon  St.  James,  who  was 
accused  before  their  council  of  transgressing 
..the  Law,  and  blaspheming  against  God. 
The  scribes  and  Pharisees  endeavoured,  by 


PHOTINIANS  583 

flattering  speeches,  to  engage  him,  at  the 
confluence  of  the  jjaschal  solemnity,  to 
undeceive  the  people  concerning  Jesus 
Christ;  and,  that  he  might  be  the  better 
heard,  they  carried  him  with  them  to  the 
top  of  the  temple.  There  they  addressed 
him  in  these  words :  "  Tell  us,  O  just  man, 
v/hat  are  we  to  believe  concerning  Jesus 
Christ,  who  was  crucified?"  He  answered 
with  a  loud  voice  :  "  He  sits  in  heaven  on 
the  right  hand  of  the  Majesty  on  high,  and 
will  come  again  in  the  clouds  of  heaven." 
Enraged  at  this  reply,  they  threw  him 
down  from  the  place  where  he  stood  ;  and 
being  very  much  bruised,  though  not  killed, 
he  recovered  strength  enough  to  get  upon 
his  knees,  and  pray  for  his  murderers,  who 
loaded  him  with  a  shower  of  stones,  till  one 
with  a  fuller's  club  beat  out  his  brains. 
Euseb.  ii.  23;  and  see  Routh,  JRel.  Sacr. 
p.  208. 

III.  In  the  Lectionary  of  St.  Jerome  and 
the  Saoramentary  of  Gregory,  the  names  of 
these  two  apostles  are  associated  together ; 
but  in  the  Eastern  Church  St.  Philip's  day 
is  November  14 ;  and  St.  James's  October 
23.  In  the  calendar  of  the  Venerable  Bede 
St.  PhUip  alone  is  mentioned  for  the  1st  of 
May;  and  in  some  early  calendar  of  the 
English  Church,  June  22  is  dedicated  to 
St.  James.  The  names  of  the  two  apostles 
however  have  been  generally  connected. 
Parallel  instances  are  those  of  SS.  Simon 
and  Jude,  SS  Peter  and  Paul,  SS.  Barnabas 
and  Bartholomew.     [H.] 

PHOTINIANS:  heretics  of  the  4th' cen- 
tury who  followed  the  teaching  of  Photinus, 
bishop  of  Sirmium  a.d.  343 ;  and  pupil  of 
Marcellus,  bishop  of  Ancyra  (Hieron.  de  Vir. 
111.  iii.  107).  Some  writers  assert  that  this 
heresy  was  a  reproduction  of  that  of  Bhion 
(see  JSbionites) :  others  that  it  resembled 
Sahellianism ;  others  still  that  Photinus 
followed  the  doctrines  of  Paul  of  Samosata 
(See  Pearson  on  Creed,  ii.  119,  note).  The 
teaching  of  Photinus,  however,  differed  from 
these,  and  went  beyond  them.  (1)  With 
regard  to  the  Trinity  he  taught  that  "  the 
Holy  Scriptures  indeed  speak  of  the  Father 
and  of  the  Son  and  of  the  Holy  Ghost ;  but 
we  are  to  understand  by  them  only  one 
Person,  who  in  Scripture  is  called  the 
Father.  What  the  Scriptures  call  the  Word 
of  God,  is  by  no  means  a  substance  or  a 
person.  Still  less  is  it  a  person  hegotten  by 
the  Father,  and  therefore  called  the  Son.  For 
with  God  there  can  be  no  generation ;  and  of 
course  He  can  have  no  Son.  Neither  is  the 
Word  that  person  who  made  the  world ;  but 
the  Word  is  properly  the  Understanding  of 
God,  which  comprehends  the  designs  of  God 
in  all  His  external  operations,  and  is  there- 
fore called  God.  The  Holy  Spirit  is  also 
not  aj^jerson,  but  an  attribute  of  God.     (2) 


584 


PICAEDS 


Hence  followed  erroneous  ideas  of  the  person 
of  Christ.  Christ  was  a  mere  man  with  no 
previous  existence,  and  began  to  be  when  He 
was  born  of  the  "Virgin  Mary.  Yet  He 
received  the  special  influences  of  Divine 
Power,  whereby  He  wrought  miracles.  This 
is  the  indwelling  of  the  Word.  On  account 
of  His  gifts  and  virtue,  God  took  Him  into  the 
place  of  a  Son  "  (Walch,  Hist,  der  Ketzereien 
lii.  9  seq.).  Marcellus  and  Photinus  were 
condemned  at  several  councils,  their  teach- 
ing being  as  obnoxious  to  the  Arians  as  to 
the  orthodox  (Soc.  E.  E.  i.  36 ;  Soz.  ii.  33). 
At  the  General  Council  of  Constantinople, 
A.r.  381,  the  Photinians  were  named  after 
the  SabeUians  in  the  general  condemnation 
of  heresies ;  and  by  the  second  Council  of 
Aries,  A.D.  451,  it  was  ordered  that  these 
heretics  (called  Photinians  or  Paulianists) 
should  be  rebaptized  before  reception  into 
the  Church  (2  Gone.  Arelat.  c.  xvi.).     [H.] 

PICAEDS :  brethren  of  the  free  spirit,  as 
they  called  themselves.  The  name  is  a 
Bohemian  form  of  Beghards.  The  Germans 
also  frequently  pronounced  the  word  Beg- 
hard,  Pychard. — Menkenius,  Script.  Germ. 
vol.  ii.  p.  1521  (See  Beghards). 

PIE  (TTiva^).  (1)  A  wooden  table  on 
which  the  directions  for  service  were  in 
early  days  written.  (2)  The  pica,  ordinale, 
or  directorium  sacerdotum.  It  was  both  a 
table  of  daily  services,  and  a  summary  of  the 
rubrics  of  the  mass.  In  the  hbrary  of  York 
Minster  there  is  a  volume  containing  the 
"  Pie  "  only.  The  instructions  are  given  in  a 
very  confused  manner,  and  Maskell  observes 
that  it  was  not  possible  for  the  same  service 
to  occur  on  the  same  Sunday  of  the  year 
twice  running.  It  is,  perhaps,  from  the 
confused  appearance  which  a  page  of  pica, 
or  pie  presents,  that  printers  came  to 
call  any  portion  of  type  which  is  in  utter 
disorder  through  accident  or  otherwise,  by 
the  name  of  "pie."  The  confusion  in  the 
"  pie,"  or  order  for  services,  was  one  of  the 
difficulties  which  our  Eefonners  had  to 
grapple  with,  in  framing  the  Prayer  Book 
(See  Preface  to  the  Prayer  Book,  "  Concern- 
ing the  Service  of  the  Church ").  The 
"pica"  type  of  later  days  took  its  name 
from  the  large  letters  in  which  the  pica, 
or  pie,  of  Anglican  Portiforia  was  printed. 
— ^Walcott,  Sac.  Arch.  p.  445 ;  Perry  in 
Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  i.  [16].     [H.] 

PIEE.  The  solid  masses  of  masonry 
between  arched  openings,  as  in  bridges, 
and  between  windows  and  doors.  This 
name  is  so  often  given  to  the  pillars  in 
Gothic  architecture,  that  it  would  be  pe- 
dantic entirely  to  disuse  it  in  that  sense ; 
but  it  ought  in  strictness  to  be  confined 
at  least  to  those  wall-like  square  pillars 
which  are  found  in  Norman  architecture ; 
as,  for  instance,  in  the  oldest  parts  of  St. 


PILLAE 

Alban's,  where  the  piers  are  made  of  bricks 
with  rubble  inside  and  plastered  all  over; 
and  alternately  with  proper  pillars  in  Dur- 
ham Cathedral,  or  in  the  nave  of  Norwich 
(See  Pillar). 

PIETISTS  :  a  name  given  to,  or  assumed 
by,  certain  Germans,  the  followers  of  Philip 
Jacob  Spener  (a.d.  1635-1705).  Spener 
was  a  man  of  ability,  and  was  a  popular 
preacher  at  Strasburg,  and  afterwards  at 
Frankfort.  He  then  was  appointed  Court 
preacher  at  Dresden,  and  in  1691  was 
made  Provost  or  Dean  of  St.  Nicolas  Church 
at  Berlin.  At  Frankfort  he  instituted 
societies  which  he  named  "  Colleges  of 
Piety,"  hence  the  name  of  his  school.  The 
theory  was  that  there  should  be  no  dog- 
matic teaching  at  all  in  the  Theological 
schools ;  that  morals  and  not  doctrine  should 
form  the  staple  of  aU  teaching;  and  that 
only  those  persons  should  be  admitted  into 
the  Lutheran  ministry  whose  lives  were 
examples  of  living  piety.  Spener's  disciples, 
as  is  usual,  far  outran  the  more  measured 
zeal  of  their  master ;  and  their  false  notions, 
amounting  sometimes  to  principles  of 
mutiny  and  sedition,  gave  rise  to  a  long  and 
bitter  controversy  in  Germany. 

The  executive  at  length  interfered,  im- 
posed severe  penal  laws,  and  finally  proscribed 
the  open  exercise  of  pietism. — Diet,  of  Sects. 

PILGEIMAGE:  A  journey  to  some 
place  deemed  sacred  and  venerable  as  as- 
sociated with  the  memory  of  Christ,  or  any 
of  the  saints,  generally  for  the  sake  of 
adoring  relics.  Pilgrimages  began  to  be 
made  in  the  fourth  century,  but  they  were 
most  in  vogue  after  the  end  of  the  eleventh 
century,  when  every  one  was  for  visiting 
places  of  devotion,  not  excepting  kings  and 
princes ;  and  even  bishops  made  no  difficulty 
of  being  absent  from  their  churches  on  the 
same  account. 

The  Pilgrim's  road  from  London  to  Can- 
terbury is  still  pointed  out  along  nearly  its 
entire  extent. 

PILLAE.  The  isolated  support  of  an 
arch,  including  base,  shaft,  and  capital,  in 
Gothic  architecture-  There  were  great 
variations  in  the  forms  of  pillars  during 
the  progress  of  ecclesiastical  architecture. 
The  Noi-man  pillar  is  often  a  square  pier- 
like mass,  sometimes  relieved  by  attached 
semi-pillars,  or  by  three-quarter  shafts  in 
retiring  angles ;  or  it  is  a  cylindrical  shaft, 
often  fluted,  or  cut  in  zigzags  or  other 
diaper  patterns.  The  early  English  piUar  fre- 
quently consists  of  a  central  bearing  shaft, 
surrounded  by  smaller  detached  shafts  ; 
either  set  almost  close  to  the  central  shaft, 
sometimes  even  within  hollows,  as  at  York, 
so  as  to  lose  the  effect  of  their  separateness, 
or  at  a  considerable  distance  from  the  central 
shaft,  as  at  Chichester  and  Ely. 


PINNACLE 

The  Geometrical  pillar  seldom  retains  the 
detached  shaft.  Its  section  when  small  is 
perhaps  more  usually  a  quatrefoil  than  any 
other  single  form ;  but  there  are  countless 
varieties,  the  mouldings  always  of  course 
following  'the  style  to  which  they  belong. 
The  later  Decorated  pillar  is  equally  various 
in  section ;  where  it  is  moulded,  the  ogee 
usually  forms  part  of  it,  but  in  small 
ajid  plain  examples  it  is  very  frequently  a 
simple  octagon.  In  the  Perpendicular  the 
pillar  follows  the  general  jxiverty  of  the 
style,  but  it  is  also  distinguished  by  the 
base  being  stilted ;  by  the  outer  mouldings 
being  continuous,  and  the  inner  order  only 
being  carried  by  an  attached  shaft  with  a 
capital,  and  sometimes  it  is  narrower  from 
east  to  west  than  from  north  to  south.  The 
exceptions,  however,  to  all  these  rules  are 
so  numerous,  that  they  could  only  be  re- 
presented by  many  illustrations. 

Norman  pillars  were  generally  of  very 
bad  construction,  with  only  rubble  inside, 
very  often  made  with  mortar  which  has 
turned  into  dust.  Indeed  that  went  on 
more  or  less  through  the  other  styles,  but 
not  so  much  as  in  the  Norman,  in  which 
the  piers  or  pillars  were  much  the  thickest. 
That  was  the  cause  of  a  great  many  Norman 
towers  falling.  They  had  however  one  merit 
which  was  very  little  continued  into  the 
later  styles  :  the  north  and  south  faces  of 
their  piers  did  not  project  beyond  the  general 
faces  of  all  the  nave  pillars,  and  therefore 
did  not  contract  the  space  under  the  tower, 
as  nearly  all  the  later  ones  did.  The  restored 
church  of  St.  Bartholomew  Smithfield  affords 
a  very  good  example  of  that.  Occasionally 
the  lower  parts  of  E.E.  tower  piers  stood 
back,  and  the  upper  part  was  corbelled  over. 
EivauLs  Abbeyis  a  beautiful  specimen  of  this. 
Constructionally  it  is  quite  safe,  because  the 
external  angles  of  the  tower  piers  are  much 
more  important  than  the  inner.     [G.] 

PINNACLE.  A  small  spire-like  ter- 
mination to  a  buttress,  or  to  any  decorative 
shaft  rising  above  the  {parapet.  In  but- 
tresses, especially  flying  buttresses,  the 
pinnacles  are  of  great  use  in  resisting  the 
outward  pressure  by  their  weight.  They 
do  not  occur  in  Norman  architecture ;  the 
earliest  example  being  at  Caen  and  Rochester 
Cathedral. 

The  pinnacle  at  the  temple  at  Jerusalem 
was  probably  the  gallery,  or  parapet,  or 
wall  on  the  top  of  the  buttresses,  which 
surrounded  the  roof  of  the  temple,  properly 
60  called.  Josephus  tells  us  that  the  roof 
of  the  temple  was  defended  by  pretty  tall 
golden  spikes,  to  hinder  birds  from  alights 
ing  thereon.  It  was  not  on  the  roof  of  the 
temple  that  Jesus  Christ  was  placed,  but 
on  the  wall  that  surrounded  the  roof. — 
Calmet's  Diet,  of  the  Bible,  ed.  Taylor 


PLURALITY 


585 


PISCINA.  Originally  signified  a  fish- 
pond ;  and  in  a  secondary  sense,  any  vessel 
for  holding  or  receiving  water.  The  font 
was  sometimes  called  a  piscina  (Optatus,  lib. 
iii.).  But  the  general  use  of  the  word  is 
applied  to  a  basin  or  stoup  at  the  south  side 
of  the  altar,  with  a  drain  from  it,  at  which 
the  sacred  vessels  were  cleansed.  The 
irisoina  is  often  the  only  remaining  indication 
of  the  place  where  an  altar  has  been.  Some 
churches  have  double  piscinas. 

PISCIS,  PISCICULI,  and  VESICA 
PISCIS.  The  fish  is  an  hieroglyphic  of 
Jesus  Christ,  very  common  in  the  remains 
of  Christian  art,  both  primitive  and  me- 
diajval.  The  origin  of  it  is  as  follows : — 
Prom  the  name  and  title  of  our  Blessed 
Lord,  'l-qtTOvs  XptoTOff  GeoO  'Yto?  ^oirrjpf 
Jesus  Christ,  the  Son  of  God,  the  Saviour, 
the  early  Christians,  taking  the  fu-st  letter 
of  each  word,  formed  the  name  'IXeVS, 
Piscis,  a  fish.  Prom  this  name  of  our 
blessed  Lord,  Christians  also  came  to  be 
called  Pisciculi,  fishes,  with  reference  to 
their  regeneration  in  the  waters  of  baptism, 
consecrated  to  that  effect  by  our  Blessed 
Lord,  the  mystical  'ixevs.  Thus  Ter- 
tullian,  speaking  of  Christians,  says,  "  for 
we,  after  our  Lord  and  Saviour  Jesus 
Christ,  our  'IxeYS,  are  also  fishes,  and 
born  in  the  water;  nor  are  we  otherwise 
saved  but  by  remaining  in  the  water." 
The  Vesica  Piscis,  which  is  the  figure  of 
an  oval,  pointed  at  either  end,  and  which 
is  much  used  as  the  form  of  the  seals  of 
religious  houses,  and  to  enclose  figures  of 
Jesus  Christ,  or  of  the  saints,  also  has  its 
rise  from  this  name  of  our  Blessed  Lord  : 
though  some  say  that  the  mystical  Vesica 
Piscis  has  no  reference,  except  in  its  name, 
to  a  fish,  but  represents  the  almond,  the 
symbol  of  virgLuity  and  self-production. 
Clement  of  Alexandria  in  writing  of  the 
ornaments  which  a  Christian  may  consis- 
tently wear,  mentions  the  fish  as  a  proper 
device  for  a  ring,  and  says  that  it  may 
serve  to  remind  the  Christian  of  the  origin 
of  his  spiritual  life. 

PLACEBO.  The  office  of  the  dead,  so 
called  from  the  first  word  in  the  Antiphon. 
The  title  is  given  to  the  office  in  some  of 
the  Prymers ;  but  in  those  of  1538,  1543, 
and  the  King's  Prymer  it  is  called  the  Dirge 
(See  Dirge).     [H.] 

PLAGAL.  The  name  given  to  the  four 
modes  or  scales  added  by  St.  Gregorj'  to 
the  Ambrosian  chants.  The  latter  were 
called  "  Authentic "  (See  Gregorian  Cliant 
Music).     [II.] 

PLANETA  (See  Chasulle). 

PLENARTY  (from  the  word  plenus^ 
"  full "),  signifying  that  a  church  is  full,  or 
provided  with  an  incumbent. 

PLURALITY.    The  principal  Act  now 


-586 


PLUEALITY 


governing  the  law  of  pluralities,  or  the 
number  of  preferments  that  may  be  held 
together  is  1  &  2  Vic.  c.  106,  which  super- 
seded all  the  previously  existing  law  on  the 
subject,  and  has  been  modified  by  13  &  14 
Vic.  c.  98,  and  practically  also  by  3  &  4  Vic. 
c.  113,  s.  34,  which  requires  archdeacons  who 
■are  also  canons  residentiary  to  reside  eight 
months  at  their  cathedrals — exactly  where 
the  arohidiaconal  functions  are  not  per- 
formed. By  these  two  Acts  together  nobody 
who  holds  more  than  one  benefice  or  canonry 
m.ay  take  or  hold  any  other ;  and  no  one 
■can  hold  canonries  in  two  cathedrals,  even 
though  one  be  honorary,  whether  that  was 
really  intended  or  not.  But  an  archdeacon 
may  hold  two  benefices  including  a  canonry, 
provided  one  of  them  is  in  the  same  diocese 
as  Ms  archdeaconry ;  a  perfectly  absurd  pro- 
vision ;  and  so  is  the  requiring  him  to  reside 
longer  at  his  cathedral  than  any  other  canon, 
■"  unless  he  is  engaged  in  performing  archi- 
•diaconal  functions  "  which  are  undefined.  An 
archdeaconry  is  also  strangely  defined  to  be  a 
■cathedral  preferment,  which  it  is  not.  And 
"benefice "means anything  with  cureof  souls, 
except  an  "assistant"  (i.e.  not  perpetual) 
curacy.  By  what  is  called  the  Pluralities  Act 
Amendment  Act,  1885,  which  contains  one 
section  (14)  about  pluralities  and  fourteen 
others  about  something  else,  a  man  may  hold 
two  livings  of  which  the  churches  are  within 
four  miles  of  the  nearest  road,  and  the  annual 
value  of  one  of  which  does  not  exceed  £200. 
The  other  may  be  of  any  value ;  and  the 
limit  of  population  also  of  the  previous  Act 
■of  1837  seems  to  be  abolished.  This  was 
passed  on  account  of  the  increasing  difficulty 
•of  filling  up  small  livings.  For  the  contents 
of  the  rest  of  the  Act,  see  Curates.  A  dis- 
pensation for  holding  two  livings  must  still 
be  got  from  the  Archbishop  of  Canterbury, 
with  an  appeal  to  the  Privy  Council  if  he 
refuses.  No  deduction  from  the  value  is 
allowed  for  curates,  taxes,  rates,  or  repairs 
in  reckoning  the  value. 

By  sec.  11  of  the  Act  of  1837  any  one  who 
accepts  what  would  be  a  plurality  contrary  to 
the  Act  may  state  to  the  bishop  before 
institution  which  of  any  two  previous  prefer- 
ments he  will  vacate,  and  it  wiU  be  vacated 
accordingly;  and  if  he  does  not,  institution 
■to  the  new  one  vacates  all  his  previous  prefer- 
ment. Consequently  in  ordinary  cases,  in- 
stitution to  a  new  living  vacates  an  old  one 
ipso  facto  without  any  formal  resignation. 
•By  the  second  of  the  above  Acts  deans  and 
canons  can  no  longer  hold  the  headship  of 
colleges,  and  deans  vacate  a  living  in  six 
months  unless  it  is  xmder  the  value  of  £500 
-a  year,  and  within  the  city ;  and  that  has 
been  decided  to  be  the  gross  value,  as  above. 

By  4  &  5  Vic.  c.  39,  an  honorary,  or 
•non-residentiary  canonry  unendowed  beyond 


PLYMOUTH  BRETHREN 

£20  a  year,  does  not  prevent  the  hold- 
ing of  two  benefices,  but  does  apparently 
prevent  the  holding  of  any  other  honorary 
canonry,  probably  per  incuriam.  And  by 
13  &  14  Vic.  c.  98,  s.  11,  they  do  not  lapse  to 
the  Crown  either  by  being  left  vacant  or 
by  promotion  of  the  canon  to  a  bishopric 
(See  Canonry  and  Besidentiary). 

The  absurd  provision  of  s.  32,  that  an 
archdeaconry,  which  are  all  of  very  little 
value,  except  the  few  that  are  attached  to 
canonries  by  Act  of  Parliament,  may  not  be 
accepted  together  with  any  other  two  pre- 
ferments unless  it  is  in  the  same  diocese 
with  one  of  them,  has  been  noticed  under 
Ardhdeacon.  A  curious  question  has  arisen 
thereon  about  the  acceptance  of  an  arch- 
deacon-canonry  in  St.  Paul's  by  the  incum- 
bent of  a  living  out  of  the  diocese  of  London. 
Two  diocesan  chancellors  separately  gave 
opinions  that  it  did  not  vacate  the  living,  on 
the  ground  that  3  &  4  Vic.  c.  113,  after 
creating  the  4th  canonry  (residentiary)  in 
St.  Paul's  and  Lincoln  (s.  17),  said  that  it 
may  be  conferred  (only)  on  one  of  the 
archdeacons  (s.  33).  It  may  be  doubtful 
whether  the  archdeacon-canon  can  after- 
wards take  a  living  out  of  the  diocese ;  but 
disabilities  have  to  be  construed  strictly,  and 
the  opinion  was  that  the  later  Act  overrides 
the  earlier,  and  contains  no  provision  that 
conferring  the  canonry  in  the  only  way  the 
bishop  can  by  the  Act  vacates  anything. 
Moreover,  the  Plurality  Act  could  not  be 
followed  if  it  did;  for  that  says  that  all 
previous  preferment  is  to  become  vacant  if 
the  man  does  not  elect  which  be  will  vacate 
before  institution.  But  the  archdeaconry 
cannot  be  vacated,  because  the  later  Act  says 
that  it  and  the  stall  shall  go  together.    [G.] 

PLUVIALE.  Another  name  for  the 
cope :  so  called  because  it  was  originally  a 
cloak,  a  defence  from  the  rain  (See  Cope). 

PLYMOUTH  BRETHREN.  A  sect 
which  originated  about  the  year  1830.  The 
principal  founder  was  a  clergyman  in  Ireland, 
who  had  before  been  a  barrister,  by  name 
Darby  ;  and  sometimes,  therefore,  the  mem- 
bers of  the  sect  were  called  "Darbyites." 
Darby  ha^ving  given  up  his  ministrations  as 
a  clergyman  in  Ireland,  established  a  small 
community  in  Dublin,  which  took  the  name 
of  "Separatists."  He  afterwards  came  to 
England,  and  went  about  preaching  inde- 
pendence in  religion  in  different  places.  As 
it  was  at  Plymouth  he  gained  the  greatest 
number  of  adherents,  the  name  of  "Ply- 
mouth Brethren  "  has  been  given  to  the  sect. 
The  "brethren,"  however,  reject  the  term 
"  sect,"  and  assert  that,  while  other  Chris- 
tians are  identified  ■with  some  particular 
section  of  the  Church  of  God,  they  are  not 
identified  with  any.  They  see  no  reason 
why  the  Church  (consisting  of  all  true  be- 


pcenula 

lievers)  which  is  really  the  Church  should 
not  bo  also  visibly  united,  having  as  its  only 
bond  to  fellowship  and  barrier  of  exclusion 
the  reception  or  rejection  of  those  vital  truths 
by  which  the  Christian  is  distinguished  from 
the  believer.  But  at  the  same  time,  in 
common  with  other  sects,  they  believe  that 
true  Christianity  can  only  be  found  among 
themselves.  Their  chief  peculiarity  is  that 
they  reject  a  separate  ministry,  and  consider 
the  idea  of  ordained  ministers  as  contrary  to 
the  teaching  of  Scripture.  The  ordinances, 
consequently,  of  the  Church,  such  as  the 
Lord's  Supper,  as  they  call  it,  which  may 
be  called  rather  a  weekly  love  feast,  in  which 
bread  and  wine  are  passed  round  from  one 
to  another,  need  no  special  person  or  minister 
to  administer  or  preside.  They  assert  that 
they  are  "  the  assembly  of  Grod,"  not  meet- 
ing together  by  human  will,  but  "  gathered 
to  Jesus  by  the  Holy  Ghost."  For  further 
account  of  this  sect  see  Dennett's  Plymouth 
Brethren,  their  Rise,  &c.,  and  more  especially 
History  and  Teaching  of  the  Plymouth 
Brethren,  by  Rev.  J.  S.  Teulon,  Prebendary 
of  Chichester,  published  by  S.  P.  C.  K.    [H.] 

POENULA  (See  Chasuble). 

POLITY,  ECCLESIASTICAL.  By  this 
is  meant  the  constitution  and  government 
of  the  Christian  Church,  considered  as  a 
society. 

Scarce  anything  in  religion  (says  a 
learned  author)  has  been  more  mistaken 
than  the  nature  and  extent  of  that  power 
which  our  Blessed  Saviour  established  in 
His  Church.  Some  have  not  only  excluded 
the  civil  magistrates  of  Christian  states 
from  having  any  concernment  in  the  ex- 
ercise of  this  power,  and  exempted  all 
persons  invested  with  it  from  the  civil 
courts  of  justice,  but  have  raised  their 
supreme  governor  of  the  Church  to  a 
supremacy,  even  in  civil  affairs,  over  the 
chief  magistrate;  insomuch  that  he  has 
pretended, 'on  some  occasions,  to  absolve 
subjects  from  their  aUegience  to  their 
lawful  princes;  and  others  have  run  so 
far  into  contrary  mistakes,  as  either  to 
derive  all  spiritual  power  wholly  from  the 
civil  magistrate,  or  to  allow  the  exercise 
thereof  to  all  Christians  without  distinc- 
tion. The  first  of  these  opinions  manifestly 
tends  to  create  divisions  in  the  State,  and 
•to  excite  subjects  to  rebel  against  their 
civil  governors :  the  latter  do  plainly  strike 
at  the  foundation  of  aU  ecclesiastical  power ; 
and  wherever  they  are  put  in  practice,  not 
only  the  external  order  and  discipline,  but 
even  the  sacraments  of  the  Church  must  be 
destroyed,  and  its  whole  constitution  be 
quite  dissolved. 

The  nature  of  ecclesiastical  polity  will 
be  best  understood  by  looking  back  to  the 
constitution     of    the     ancient     Christian 


POLITY 


587 


Church.  The  Church  as  a  society  con- 
sisted of  several  orders.  Eusebius  reckons 
three :  viz.,  the  'H-yov/xei/oi,  HuttoI,  and 
KaTjjxoviievoi,  i.e.  rulers,  believers,  and 
catechumens.  Origen  I'eckons  five  orders : 
but  then  he  divides  the  clergy  into  three 
orders,  to  make  up  the  number.  Both 
these  accounts,  when  compared  together, 
came  to  the  same  thing.  Under  the  'Hyou- 
fifvoi,  or  rulers,  are  comprehended  the 
clergy,  bishops,  priests,  and  deacons ; 
under  the  llurrol,  or  believers,  the  baptized 
laity;  and  under  the  KarTjxoiiifvoi,  or 
catechumens,  the  candidates  for  baptism. 
The  believers  were  perfect  Christians;  the 
catechumens  imperfect.  The  former,  having 
received  baptism,  were  allowed  to  partake 
of  the  Eucharist;  to  join  in  all  the  prayers 
of  the  Church ;  and  to  hear  discourses  upon 
the  most  profound  mysteries  of  religion ; 
more  particularly  the  use  of  the  Lord's 
Prayer  was  the  sole  prerogative  of  the 
believers,  whence  it  was  called  EixT  irurrav, 
the  prayer  of  believers.  From  all  these 
privileges  the  catechumens  were  excluded 
(See  Catechumens). 

The  distinction  between  the  laity  and  the 
clergy  may  be  deduced  from  the  very  be- 
ginnings of  the  Christian  Church ;  notwith- 
standing that  Rigaltius,  Salmasius,  and 
Selden  pretend  there  was  originally  no 
distinction,  but  that  it  is  a  novelty,  and 
owing  to  the  ambition  of  the  clergy  of  the 
third  century,  in  which  Cyprian  and  Ter- 
tullian  lived  (See  Clergy). 

The  clergy  of  the  Christian  Church  con- 
sisted of  several  orders,  both  superior  and 
inferior.  The  superior  orders  of  the  clergy 
were,  1.  The  Bishops ;  2.  The  Presbyters ; 
3.  The  Deacons.  It  has  been  pretended  that 
the  bishops  and  presbyters  were  the  same  ; 
and  this  opinion  has  given  rise  to  the  sect  of 
the  Presbyterians.  But  it  is  clearly  proved 
against  them,  from  ecclesiastical  antiquity, 
that  bishops  and  presbyters  were  distinct 
orders  of  the  clergy  (See  Bishops,  Deacons, 
Presbyters,  and  Presbyterians). 

Among  the  bishops  there  was  a  sub- 
ordination, they  being  distinguished  into, 
1.  Primates  and  Metropolitans ;  2.  Patriarchs 
and  Archbishops ;  3.  Diocesan  Bishops ;  4. 
Chorepiscopi  or  Suffragan  Bishops  (See 
the  articles  Archbishops,  Chorepiscopi,  Dio- 
cese, Patriarchs,  and  Primates).  The  Pres- 
byters were  the  second  order  of  the  superior 
clergy,  and  besides  being  the  bishop's  assist- 
ants in  his  cathedral  church,  had  the  care 
of  the  smaller  districts,  or  parishes,  of  which 
each  diocese  consisted  (See  Parishes  and 
Presbyters).  The  deacons  were  the  third 
order  of  the  superior  clergy,  and  were  assist- 
ants to  the  bishops  and  presbyters,  in  the 
administration  of  the  Eucharist,  and  other 
parts  of  Divine  service.     There  were  like- 


588 


POLYGLOTT  BIBLES 


wise  deaconesses,  or  female  deacons,  who 
were  employed  in  the  service  of  the  women. 
Out  of  the  order  of  deacons  was  chosen  the 
archdeacon,  who  presided  over  the  deacons 
and  all  the  inferior  officers  of  the  Church 
(See  the  articles  Archdeacons,  Beacons,  and 
JDeaconesses). 

The  inferior  orders  of  the  clergy  were, 
1.  The  Sub-deacons ;  2.  The  Acolyths ;  3. 
The  Exorcists;  4.  The  Readers;  5.  The 
Door-keepers;  6.  The  Singers;  7.  The 
Copiatse,  or  Fossarii ;  8.  The  Parabolani ; 
9.  The  Catechists;  10.  The  Syndics;  11. 
The  Stewards  (See  each  under  their  re- 
spective articles'). 

We  retain  only  the  general  distinction  of 
hishops,  presbyters  or  priests,  and  deacons. 
Among  the  first  we  retain  the  distinction  of 
archbishops  (with  the  title  likewise  of  pri- 
mates) and  bishops,  having  no  patriarchs  or 
chorepiscopi.  And  as  to  the  inferior  orders 
of  the  clergy,  as  acolyths,  &c.,  they  are  all 
extinct  in  the  Church  of  England.  The 
Eomish  Church  has  retained  most  of  them. 

No  society  can  subsist  without  laws, 
and  penalties  annexed  to  the  breach  of 
them,  so  the  unity  and  worship  of  the 
Christian  Church  were  secured  by  laws 
both  ecclesiastical  and  civil.  The  eccle- 
siastical laws  were,  either  rules  and  orders 
made  by  each  bishop  for  the  better  regu- 
lation of  his  particular  diocese ;  or  laws 
made,  in  provincial  synods,  for  the  govern- 
ment of  ail  the  dioceses  of  a  province ;  or, 
lastly,  laws  respecting  the  whole  Christian 
Church,  made  in  general  councils,  or  as- 
semblies of  bishops  from  all  parts  of  the 
Christian  world  (See  Synods').  The  civil 
laws  of  the  Church  were  those  decrees  and 
edicts,  made  from  time  to  time  by  the  em- 
perors or  the  State,  either  restraining  the 
power  of  the  Church,  or  ratifying  canons 
made  by  the  clergy  in  some  of  the  preceding 
ways,  or  otherwise  making  laws  for  the 
Church.  The  breach  of  these  laws  was  se- 
verely punished  both  by  the  Church  and 
State.  The  ecclesiastical  censures,  respecting 
offenders  among  the  clergy,  were,  chiefly, 
suspension  from  the  office,  and  deprivation 
of  the  rights  and  privileges  of  the  order. 
Those  respecting  the  laity  consisted  chiefly 
in  excommunication,  or  rejection  from  the 
communion  of  the  Church,  and  penance 
both  public  and  private,  q.v. 

POLYGLOTT  BIBLES,  are  such  Bibles, 
or  editions  of  the  Holy  Scriptures,  as  are 
printed  in  various  languages,  at  least  three, 
the  texts  of  which  are  ranged  in  opposite 
columns.  Some  of  these  Polyglott  editions 
contain  the  whole  Bible,  others  but  a  part 
of  it.  The  principal  Polyglotts  that  have 
yet  appeared  are  these  following : — 

1.  The  Bible  of  Francis  Ximenes,  car- 
dinal of  the  order  of  St.  Francis.     It  was 


POLYGLOTT  BIBLES 

printed  ha  1514-17,  in  four  languages — 
Hebrew,  Chaldee,  Greek,  and  Latin.  From 
having  been  printed  at  Alcala,  in  Spain, 
anciently  Complutum,  this  is  called  the- 
Complutensian  Polyglott.  It  cost  Cardinal 
Ximenes  50,000  ducats. 

2.  The  Psalter  of  Justiniani,  bishop  of 
Nebbio,  of  the  order  of  St.  Dominic.  It 
appeared  in  1516,  in  five  languages;  He- 
brew, Chaldee,  Greek,  Latin,  and  Arabic. 

3.  The  Psalter,  by  John  Potken,  provost 
of  the  Collegiate  Church  of  St.  George,  at 
Cologne,  published  in  1518,  in  four  lan- 
guages —  Hebrew,  Greek,  Chaldee,  and 
Latin. 

4.  The  Pentateuch,  published  by  the 
Jews,  at  Constantinople,  in  1546,  in  He- 
brew, Chaldee,  Persian,  and  Arabic;  with 
the  commentaries  of  Solomon  Jarchi. 

5.  The  Pentateuch,  by  the  same  Jews,  in 
the  same  city,  in  1547,  in  four  languages — 
Hebrew,  Chaldee,  the  vulgar  Greek,  and 
Spanish. 

6.  An  imperfect  Polyglott,  containing 
only  fragments  of  the  book  of  Genesis  and 
of  the  Psalms ;  the  Proverbs,  the  prophets 
Micah  and  Joel,  with  part  of  Isaiah,  Ze- 
chariah,  and  Malachi;  published  by  John 
Draconitis,  of  Carlostad,  in  Franconia,  in 
1563-5,  in  five  languages — Hebrew,  Chal- 
dee, Greek,  Latin,  and  German. 

7.  Christopher  Plantin's  Polyglott  Bible, 
published  by  order  of  Philip  II.,  king  of 
Spain,  Antwerp,  in  1569,  1572.  It  is  in 
eight  volumes,  -^andi  in  Hebrew,  Chaldee, 
Greek  and  Latin;  with  the  Syriac  version 
of  the  New  Testament.  This  is  called  the 
Antwerp  Polyglott. 

8.  Vatablus's  Polyglott  Bible,  being  the 
Old  Testament  in  Hebrew  and  Greek,  with 
two  Latin  versions,  one  of  St.  Jerome,  the 
other  of  Sanctus  Pagninus;  and  Vata- 
blus's notes.  The  editorship  is  attributed 
to  E.  Stephens,  by  Bishop  Walton.  Dibdin 
ascribes  it  to  Bertramus,  Hebrew  professor  at 
Geneva.     It  appeared  at  Heidelberg  in  1586. 

9.  A  Bible  in  four  languages,  Hebrew, 
Greek,  Latin,  and  German,  published  by 
David  Wolder,  a  Lutheran  minister,  at 
Hamburg,  in  1596. 

10.  The  Polyglotts  of  Elias  Hutter,  a 
German.  The  first,  printed  at  Nurem- 
berg, in  1599,  contains  the  Pentateuch, 
Joshua,  Judges,  and  Euth,  in  six  lan- 
guages; viz.  the  Hebrew,  Chaldee,  Greek, 
Latin,  Luther's  German,  and  Sclavonian; 
or  French,  Italian,  or  Saxon;  the  copies 
varying  according  to  the  nations  they  were 
designed  for. 

This  author  published  the  Psalter  and 
New  Testament,  in  Hebrew,  Greek,  Latin, 
and  German.  But  his  chief  work  is  the 
New  Testament  in  twelve  languages,  viz. 
Syriac,   Greek,   Hebrew,  Italian,   Spanish, 


POLYGLOTT  PRAYER  BOOK 

^French,  Latin,  German,  Bohemian,  Englisli, 
Danish,  and  Polish.  This  was  printed  at 
Nuremberg  in  1599. 

11.  M.  le  Jay's  Bible,  in  seven  languages, 
printed  at  Paris  in  1615.     The  languages 

^ire,  the  Hebrew,  Samaritan,  Chaldee,  Greek, 
Syriac,  Latin,  and  Arabic. 

12.  Walton's  Polyglott,  published  in 
England,  in  1657 ;  in  nine  languages,  viz. 
.the  Hebrewr,  Chaldee,  Greek,  Samaritan, 
Syrian,  Arabic,  .^thiopic,  Persic,  and  Latin; 
though  no  one  book  is  printed  in  so  many. 
This  was  the  most  complete  and  perfect 
Polyglott  ever  published.  It  consists  of 
five  volumes,  with  prolegomena,  by  Walton, 
which  are  in  themselves  a  treasure  of  biblical 
icriticism,  some  treatises  in  the  first  volume, 
several  new  Oriental  versions  in  the  fourth 
and  fifth,  and  a  very  large  collection  of 
various  readings  in  the  sixth. 

13.  Eeineccius',  or  the  Leipsic  Polyglott, 
printed  at  Leipsic,  1753,  in  3  vols.,  in  Latin, 
German,  Hebrew,  and  Greek :  a  cheap  and 
commodious  edition. 

14.  Bagster's  Polyglott,  London,  1821, 
4to  and  8vo,  in  five  languages,  Hebrew, 
Greek,  Latin,  English",  Syriac.  They  are 
also  printed  separately  as  small  books, 

POLYGLOTT  PRAYER  BOOK.  The 
English  Prayer  Book  was  published  in  1819 
by  Bagster  in  eight  languages,  English, 
French,  Italian,  German,  Spanish,  ancient 
and  modern  Greek,  and  Latin. 

PONTIFICAL.  A  book  containing 
offices  and  other  rites  used  by  a  bishop,  at 
consecration  of  churches,  &c.,  some  of  which 
could  only  be  performed  by  a  bishop,  and 
none  except  by  those  to  whom  special  licence 
and  commission  were  given.  "Liber  minis- 
terialis"  seems  to  have  been  commonly 
used  for  Pontifical  in  England  in  the  ninth 
and  tenth  centuries  (Wilkins,  Cone.  i. 
169).  Copies  of  Pontificals  are  very  scarce. 
Some  English  Pontificals  are  kept  in  hbraries 
abroad,  the  most  famous  being  that  of 
Egbert,  archbishop  of  York,  in  the  Paris 
Library  (Maskell,  1.  cxxxii.).  In  England 
at  the  present  time  the  Pontifical  is  not 
by  authority  published  separat-ely  from  the 
Liturgy,  so  that  it  is  never  called  by  that 
name;  though  the  offices  of  confirmation 
and  ordination,  in  fact,  compose  the  English 
Pontifical.  For  the  consecration  of  churches 
And  churchyards  we  have  no  office  appointed 
by  sufficient  authority  (See  Gonsecration 
■of  Churches). 

PONTIFICALIA.  Properly  the  ensigns 
of  a  pontiff's  or  bishop's  office ;  but  the  term 
is  loosely  used  for  any  ecclesiastical  dress. 
It  is  so  used  in  the  account  of  Bishop 
Andrewes'  consecration  of  St.  Mary's,  South- 
ampton, in  Sparrow's  collection :  "  Epi- 
scopus  capellam  statim  ingressus  induit  se 
pontificalibus." 


POPE 


589 


POOR  MAN'S  BOX.  Till  the  last  re- 
view of  the  Prayer  Book  it  was  directed 
that  the  collection  at  the  offertory  should 
be  put  into  the  Poor  Man's  .Box :  a  term 
which  (in  imitation  of  the  Scotch  liturgy) 
was  altered  in  the  last  review  to  a  decent 
lasin.  It  is  clear,  however,  from  many 
documents,  that  basins  of  gold  and  silver, 
and  other  material,  were  used  in  the  Church 
of  England  ever  since  the  Reformation.  In 
Ireland  the  Poor  Man's  Box,  or  poor-box,  as 
it  is  generally  called,  is  still  in  general  use. 
It  is  an  oval  box,  half  covered,  of  copper  or 
wood,  with  a  long  handle.  The  Poor  Man's 
Box  does  not  seem  to  be  the  same  as  the 
Alms'  Chest,  prescribed  by  the  Sith  canon. 
So  Wheatly  observes:  "Not,  I  presume, 
into  that  fixed  in  the  church,  but  into  a 
little  box  which  the  churchwardens,  or 
some  other  proper  persons,  carried  about 
with  them  in  their  hands,  as  is  still  the 
custom  at  the  Temple  Church  in  London." 

POPE,  THE.  The  sovereign  pontiff,  or 
supreme  head,  of  the  Romish  Church.  The 
appellation  of  pope  {Papa)  was  anciently 
given  to  all  Christian  bishops;  but,  about 
the  latter  end  of  the  eleventh  century,  in 
the  pontificate  of  Gregory  VII.,  it  was 
usurped  by  the  Bishop  of  Rome,  whose 
peculiar  title  it  has  ever  since  continued. 

The  manner  of  the  election  of  a  pope  is 
as  follows :  nine  or  ten  days  after  the 
funeral  of  a  deceased  pope,  the  cardinals 
enter  the  conclave,  which  is  generally  held 
in  the  Vatican,  in  a  long  gallery,  where 
cells  of  board  are  erected,  covered  with 
purple  cloth,  one  for  each  cardinal. 

The  election  is  made  by  scrutiny,  access, 
or  adoration.  The  first  is  when  each  car- 
dinal writes  the  name  of  him  whom  he 
votes  for  in  a  scroll  of  five  pages.  On  the 
first  is  written  by  one  of  his  servants  that 
the  cardinal  may  not  be  discovered  by  his 
hand,  "  Ego  eligo  in  sumraum  pontificem 
reverendum   Doniinum  meum    cardinalem 

."     On  this  fold  two  others  are  doubled 

down  and  sealed  with  a  private  seal.  On 
the  fourth  the  cardinal  writes  his  own  name, 
and  covers  it  with  the  fifth  folding.  Then, 
sitting  in  order  on  benches  in  the  chapel, 
with  their  scrolls  in  their  hands,  they  go 
up  to  the  altar  by  turns,  and,  after  a  short 
prayer  on  their  knees,  throw  the  scroll  into 
a  chalice  upon  the  table,  the  first  cardinal 
bishop  sitting  on  the  right  hand,  and  the 
first  cardinal  deacon  on  the  left.  The 
cardinals  being  returned  to  their  places, 
the  cardinal  bishop  turns  out  the  scrolls 
into  a  plate,  which  ho  holds  in  his  left 
hand,  and  gives  them  one  by  one  to  the 
cardinal  deacon,  who  reads  them  with  an 
audible  voice,  while  the  cardinals  note 
down  how  many  voices  each  person  has  ; 
and    then   the  master  of  the  ceremonies 


590 


POPE 


bums  the  scrolls  in  a  chafing-dish,  that  it 
may  not  be  known  for  whom  any  one  gives 
his  voice.  If  two-thirds  of  the  number 
present  agree,  the  election  is  made,  and 
he  on  whom  the  two-thirds  fall  is  declared 
pope. 

When  the  choice  is  made  by  access,  the 
cardinals  rise  from  their  places,  and,  ap- 
proaching him  whom  they  would  have 
elected,  say,  Ego  accedo  ad  reverendissi- 
mum  JDominum.  The  choice  by  adoration 
is  much  after  the  same  manner,  only  the 
cardinal  approaches  him  whom  he  would 
have  chosen  with  the  profoundest  rever- 
ence. But  both  the  one  and  the  other 
must  be  confirmed  by  the  scrutiny. 

There  has  been  another  way  of  choosing 
a  pope,  namely,  by  compromise;  that  is, 
when  the  differences  have  risen  so  high 
that  they  could  not  be  adjusted  in  the 
conclave,  they  have  referred  the  choice  to 
three  or  five,  giving  them  leave  to  elect 
any  one,  provided  it  were  determined 
within  the  time  that  a  candle  lighted  by 
common  consent  should  last.  Sometimes 
they  have  had  recourse  to  what  is  called 
inspiration ;  that  is,  the  first  cardinal  rises 
up  in  chapel,  and,  after  an  exhortation  to 
make  choice  of  a  capable  person,  imme- 
diately, as  if  inspired,  names  one  himself : 
to  which,  if  two-thirds  of  the  cardinals  pre- 
sent agree,  he  is  reckoned  legally  chosen. 

When  one  of  the  cardinals  is  chosen  pope, 
the  master  of  the  ceremonies  comes  to  his 
cell,  to  acquaint  him  with  the  news  of  his 
promotion.  Whereupon  he  is  conducted  to 
the  chapel,  and  clad  in  the  pontifical  habit, 
and  there  receives  the  adoration,  or  the 
respects  paid  by  the  cardinals  to  the  popes. 
Then,  all  the  gates  of  the  conclave  being 
opened,  the  new  pope  shows  himself  to  the 
people,  and  blesses  them,  the  first  cardinal 
deacon  proclaiming  aloud  these  words : 
Annuntio  vdbis  gaudium  magnum ;  Papam 
habemus.  Severendissimus  Dominus  Carin- 

alis electus  est  in  summum  Pontificem, 

et  eligit  sibi  nomen .    After  this  he  is 

carried  to  St.  Peter's  church,  and  placed 
upon  the  altar  of  the  holy  apostles,  where 
the  cardinals  come  a  second  time  to  the 
adoration.  Some  days  after  is  performed 
the  ceremony  of  his  coronation,  before  the 
door  of  St.  Peter's  church,  where  is  erected 
a  throne,  upon  which  the  new  pope  ascends, 
has  his  mitre  taken  off,  and  a  crown  put 
upon  his  head,  in  the  presence  of  the  peo- 
ple. Afterwards  is  a  grand  cavalcade  from 
St.  Peter's  church  to  St.  John  Lateran, 
where  the  archbishop  of  that  church  pre- 
sents the  new  pope  with  two  keys,  one  of 
gold  the  other  of  silver. 

It  is  probable  that,  in  the  first  ages  of  the 
Church,  the  Eoman  clergy  elected  the  pope; 
and  some  think  the  people  had  a  share  in 


POPE 

the  election.    Afterwards,  Odoacer,  king  ol 
the  Heruli,  and  Theodoric,  king  of  the  Goths 
in  Italy,  would  suffer  no  election  of  a  pope 
to  be  made  without  their  consent.    But  this- 
was  abolished  in  502,  under  Pope  Sym- 
machus.     The  succeeding  princes,  however, 
reserved  to  themselves  a  right  to  confirm 
the  newly  elected  pope,  who,  without  this 
confirmation,  could  not  take  possession  of 
the  pontificate.     The  tenth  century  saw 
several  popes  elected  and  deposed  at  the 
fancy  of  the  Eoman  nobility  and  Italian 
princes.    But,  since  the  election  of  Celestine 
IL,  in  1443,  the  cardinals  have  retained  the 
power  of  election,  independent  of  the  Eomaa . 
people,  or  of  any  sovereign  prince  whatever. 
It  is  a  general  maxim,  in  the  choice  of 
a  pope,  to  elect  an  Italian  ;  which  is  done, 
not  only  because  they  choose  rather    to 
bestow  this  dignity  on  a  native  of  Italy 
than  on  a  foreigner,  but  also  because  the 
security    and    preservation    of    the    papal 
chair  depends,  in  a  great  measure,  on  the 
balance  which  is  to  be  kept  between  Trance 
and  Spain :  but  this  is  not  to  be  expected 
from  a  French  or  Spanish  pope,  who  would 
quickly  turn  the  scale,  and,  by  granting 
too  great  privileges  to  his  countrjanen,  en- 
deavour to  exclude  others  from  the  papal 
chair.     It  is  also  a  sort  of  maxim  to  choose 
a  pope  who  is  pretty  far  advanced  in  years, 
that  there  may  be  the  quicker  succession, 
and  that  it  may  not  be  in  the  power  of  a 
pope,  during  a  long  reign,  to  alter  their 
customs,   or,  by  making    his    family  too 
powerful,  to  entail,  as  it  were,  the  papal 
chair  upon  his  house.     They  also  take  care 
that  he  be  not  too  near  akin  to  the  deceased 
pope,  that  the  vacant  church  benefices  may 
not  be  engrossed  by  one  family.     It  often 
happens  that  one  is  chosen  pope  of  whom 
nobody  thought  before;  and  this  comes  to 
pass  when  the  cardinals  are  tired  out  by  so 
many  intrigues,  and  are  glad  to  get  out  of 
the  conclave.     For  a  long  time  there  was  a 
traditionaiy  belief  that  no  pope  would  rei^n 
twenty-five  years,  but  Pius  VI.  reigned  from 
1775  to  1800,  and  Pius  IX.  from  1846  ta 
1878. 

Many  of  the  popes  have  made  it  their 
business  to  enrich  their  families  out  of  the 
Church  revenues,  of  which  there  are  very 
remarkable  instances.  For  it  is  related  that 
Sixtus  v.,  during  a  reign  of  five  years,  be- 
stowed upon  his  family  above  three  millions 
of  ducats.  The  house  of  the  Barbarini,  at 
the  death  of  Urban  VIII.,  was  possessed  of 
227  ofiices  and  Church  benefices,  whereby 
they  amassed  thirty  millions  of  scudi. 

The  first  pope  who  assumed  a  new 
name  on  his  election  was  Octavian,  who- 
took  the  title  of  John  XII.,  November  a.d. 
965.  "  The  civil  government  seems  to  have 
been  conducted  in  that"  (i.e.  the  name)' 


POPE 

"of  Octavian,  the  church  was  administered 
under  that  of  Jolm  XII." — Milman,  Hist. 
Lat.  Christ,  ii.  387. 

When  a  pope  is  elected,  they  put  on  him 
a  cassock  of  white  wool,  shoes  of  red  cloth, 
on  which  is  embroidered  a  gold  cross,  a 
mantle  of  red  velvet,  the  rochet,  the  white 
linen  albe,  and  a  stole  set  with  pearls.  At 
home  Ms  habit  is  a  white  silk  cassock, 
rochet,  and  scarlet  mantle.  In  winter  his 
Holiness  wears  a  fur  cap ;  in  summer,  a 
satin  one.  When  he  celebrates  mass,  the 
colour  of  his  habit  varies  according  to  the 
solemnity  of  the  festival.  At  Whitsuntide, 
and  all  festivals  of  the  martyrs,  he  officiates 
in  red ;  at  Easter,  and  all  festivals  of 
virgins,  in  white;  in  Lent,  Advent,  and 
eves  of  fasting  days,  in  violet;  and  on 
Easter-eve,  and  at  all  masses  for  the  dead, 
in  black.  All  these  colours  are  typical : 
the  red  expresses  the  cloven  tongue,  and  the 
blood  of  the  martyrs;  the  white,  the  joy 
caused  by  our  Saviour's  resurrection,  and 
the  chastity  of  virgins ;  the  violet,  the  pale 
aspect  of  those  who  fast ;  and  the  black, 
grief  and  mourning. 

The  Pope  has  two  seals ;  one  is  called 
"  the  fisherman's  ring,"  and  is  the  impression 
of  St.  Peter  holding  a  line  with  a  bait  to  it 
in  the  water.  It  is  used  for  those  briefs 
that  are  sealed  with  red  wax.  The  other 
seal  is  used  for  the  bulls  which  are  sealed 
with  lead,  and  bears  the  figures  of  St.  Peter 
and  St.  Paul,  with  a  cross  on  one  side,  and  a 
bust,  with  the  name  of  the  reigning  pope, 
on  the  other.  Upon  the  decease  of  a  pope, 
these  seals  are  defaced  and  broken  by  the 
cardinal  Camerlengo,  in  the  presence  of  three 
cardinals. 

When  the  pope  goes  in  procession  to  St. 
Peter's,  the  cross  is  carried  before  him  on 
the  end  of  a  pike  about  ten  palms  long. 
"  Many  reasons,"  says  F.  Bonani,  "  au- 
thorise this  custom.  It  is  a  monument  of 
the  sufferings  of  Jesus  Christ,  and  of  the 
pope's  adherence  to  the  Saviour  of  the 
world.  It  is  the  true  mark  of  the  pontifical 
dignity,  and  represents  the  authority  of  the 
Church,  as  the  Eoman  fasces  did  that  of  the 
consuls."  At  the  same  time  two  grooms 
bear  two  fans  on  each  side  of  bis  Holiness's 
chair,  to  drive  away  the  flies.  This  (ac- 
cording to  the  above-cited  author)  re- 
presents the  seraphim  covering  the  face  of 
God  with  their  wings. 

The  custom  of  kissing  the  pope's  feet  is 
very  ancient ;  to  justify  which  practice,  it 
is  alleged,  that  the  pope's  slipper  has  the 
figure  of  the  cross  upon  the  upper  leather ; 
so  that  it  is  not  the  pope's  foot,  but  the 
cross  of  Christ,  which  is  thus  saluted. 
There  were  at  different  times  between  a.d. 
250  and  1438,  antipopes,  or  pretenders  to 
the  bishopric  of  Rome.  According  to  Gedde's 


POPERY 


591J 


list  there  were  twenty-four  (Miscell.  Tracts, 
vol.  iii.  t.  4,  Lond.  1706),  but  other  writers 
assert  that  there  were  more.  There  were 
two  classes  of  antipopes — (i.)  those  elected 
during  the  lifetime  of  a  pope  canonically  in 
possession;  (ii.)  those  whose  own  election 
was  itself  invalid.  Very  often  the  dispute 
was  the  occasion  of  much  bloodshed  (See 
Gibbon,  iii.  255:  v.  144:  vii.  128:  vhi. 
251,  &c.).  In  1870  a  decree  of  the  Vatican 
Council  declared  the  pope  infallible.  In. 
the  same  year  the  pope  lost  his  temporal 
possessions  and  power,  which  were  taken  by 
the  King  of  Italy. 

II.  There  are  but  few  instances  of  the 
papal  power  in  England  before  the  Norman 
conquest.  But  the  pope,  having  favoured  and 
supported  William  I.  in  his  invasion  of  this- 
kingdom,  made  that  a  handle  for  eularging- 
his  encroachments,  and,  in  that  king's  reign 
began  to  send  legates  hither.  Afterwards, 
he  prevailed  with  King  Henry  I.  to  part 
with  the  right  of  nominating  to  bishoprics  ; 
and,  in  the  reign  of  King  Stephen,  he 
gained  the  prerogative  of  appeals.  In  the- 
reign  of  Henry  II.  he  exempted  all  clerks 
from  the  secular  power.  This  king,  at  first,, 
strenuously  opposed  his  innovation;  but, 
after  the  death  of  Becket,  who,  for  having 
violently  opposed  the  king,  was  slain  by 
some  of  the  royal  adherents,  the  pope  got 
such  an  advantage  over  the  king,  that  he- 
was  never  able  to  execute  the  laws  he  had 
made.  Not  long  after  this,  by  a  general  ex- 
communication of  the  king  and  his  people, 
for  several  years.  King  John  was  reduced 
to  such  straits,  that  he  surrendered  his 
kingdoms  to  the  pope,  to  receive  them 
again,  and  hold  them  of  him  under  a  rent 
of  a  thousand  marks.  In  the  following 
reign  of  Henry  III.,  partly  from  the  profits 
of  our  best  Church  benefices,  and  partly 
from  the  taxes  imposed  by  the  pope,  there- 
went  yearly  out  of  the  kingdom  to  Home 
£70,000  sterling.  But  in  the  reign  of 
Edward  I.,  it  was  declared  by  the  Par- 
liament, that  the  pope's  taking  upon  him  to- 
dispose  of  English  benefices  to  foreigners, 
was  an  encroachment  not  to  be  endured;, 
and  this  was  followed  by  the  statute  of 
Provisors  against  popish  bulls,  and  against 
disturbing  any  patron,  in  presenting  to  a 
benefice,  which  was  afterwards  enacted  in 
Ireland  also. 

But  the  pope's  power  received  a  mortal- 
blow  in  England,  by  the  reformation  in 
religion,  begim  in  the  reign  of  Henry  VIII. ; 
since  which  time,  to  maintain  the  pope's 
authority  here,  by  writing,  preaching,  &c., 
was,  till  lately,  made  a  premunire  upon  the 
first  conviction,  and  high  treason  upon  the 
second  (See  Church  of  Rome ;  Supremacy,. 
Papal). — Ranke's  Hist,  of  Popes. 

POPERY  (See  Church  of  Eoine;  Council' 


592 


POPEEY 


of  Trent ;  Romanism).  By  this  term  is 
meant  the  peculiar  system  of  doctrine,  by 
adopting  which  the  Church  of  Rome  has 
departed  from  the  primitive  simplicity  of 
the  Catholic  Church,  by  requiring  all  who 
communicate  with  her  to  believe,  as  ne- 
cessary to  salvation,  certain  mediseval  ideas, 
such  as . — 1.  That  the  holy  images  are  to  be 
honoured  and  revered;  2.  That  the  Virgin 
Mary  and  other  saints  are  to  be  prayed  to ; 
3.  That,  after  consecration  in  the  Lord's 
Supper,  the  bread  is  no  longer  bread,  and 
the  wine  no  longer  wine ;  4.  That  the 
clergyman  should  be  excommunicated  who, 
in  the  sacrament  of  the  Lord's  Supper,  gives 
the  cup  to  the  people ;  5.  That  they  are  ac- 
cursed who  say  that  the  clergy  may  marry  ; 
6.  That  there  is  a  purgatory — that  is,  a 
place  where  souls  which  had  died  in  re- 
pentance are  purified  by  suffering ;  7.  That 
the  Church  of  Rome  is  the  mother  and 
mistress  of  all  Churches ;  8.  That  obedience 
is  due  from  all  Churches  to  the  bishop  of 
Rome;  9.  That  they  are  accursed  who 
deny  that  there  are  seven  sacraments. 

Prom  those  doctrines,  contrary  to  Scrip- 
ture and  the  primitive  Church,  have  resulted 
sundry  evil  practices.  From  the  veneration 
of  images  has  sprung  the  actual  worship  of 
them.  The  invocation  of  the  Blessed  Vir- 
gin, and  of  other  saints,  has  given  rise  to  the 
greatest  superstition  and  profaneness.  The 
bread  in  the  Eucharist  has  been  worshipped 
as  though  itself  were  the  eternal  God.  From 
the  doctrine  of  purgatory  has  sprung  that  of 
indulgences,  and  the  practice  of  persons 
paying  sums  of  money  to  the  Roman  bishops 
and  clergy,  to  release  the  souls  of  their 
friends  from  the  fabulous  fire  of  purgatory 
(See  Indulgences). 

Dates  may  be  given  to  show  that  all  the 
peculiar  doctrines  and  practices  of  the  Ro- 
manists are  of  medioBval  or  modern  origin. 

Attrition,  as  distinguished  from  con- 
trition, was  first  pronounced  to  be  sufficient; 
the  priest's  right  intention  was  first  pro- 
nounced to  be  indispensable  to  the  valid 
participation  of  the  sacraments ;  and  judicial 
absolution  was  first 'publicly  authorised ;  all 
by  the  Council  of  Trent,  a.d.  1551. 

Auricular  confession  was  first  enjoined 
by  Innocent  III.,  at  the  fourth  Council  of 
Lateran,  a.d.  1215. 

Compulsory  celibacy  of  the  clergy  was 
first  enjoined  publicly  at  the  first  Council 
of  Lateran,  A.D.  1123. 

Gommwnion  in  one  hind  only  was  first 
authoritatively  sanctioned  by  the  Council  of 
Constance,  a.d.  1414:. 

Use  of  images  and  relics  in  religious 
worship  was  first  publicly  affirmed  and 
«anctioned  in  the  second  Council  of  Nice, 
A.D.  787. 

Invocation  of  saints  was  first  taught  with 


PORCH 

authority  by  the  fourth  Council  of  Con- 
stantinople, A.D.  754. 

Papal  infallibility  was  utterly  unknown 
to  the  third  Council  of  Constantinople. 
A.D.  680,  and  never  formally  asserted  till 
1870. 

Papal  supremacy  was  first  publicly  as- 
serted by  the  fourth  Council  of  Lateran, 
A.D.  1215. 

Prayers  in  a  foreign  tongue,  first  deliber- 
ately sanctioned  by  the  Council  of  Trent, 
were  expressly  forbidden  by  the  fourth 
Council  of  Lateran,  a.d.  1215. 

Purgatory  and  indulgences  were  first  set 
forth  by  the  Council  of  Florence,  a.d.  1438. 

The  Roman  number  of  the  sacraments 
was  first  taught  by  the  Council  of  Trent, 
A.D.  1545. 

Transubstantiation  was  first  publicly  in- 
sisted on  by  the  fourth  Council  of  Lateran, 
A.D.  1215. 

Tlie  immaculate  conception  of  the  Virgin 
Mary  was  first  declared  in  1868. 

POPPY  HEAD.  The  ornamental  finial 
of  a  stall  end.  In  design  the  poppy  heads 
are  extremely  various ;  but  they  are  almost 
universally  made  to  assume  the  outline  of 
the  fleur-de-lis,  to  which  not  only  foliage, 
but  figures,  faces,  and  whole  groups  are 
made  to  conform  themselves. 

PORCH.  Every  one  knows  what  the 
porch  or  porches  of  a  church  are,  better 
than  by  any  explanation.  They  differ 
widely  in  size ;  and  though  there  are  a  few 
considerable  Norman  porches,  as  at  South- 
well, they  acquired  greater  importance  in 
the  later  styles.  The  largest  and  grandest 
porches  are  nearly  all  northern  ones.  In 
cathedrals  that  might  arise  from  the  cloisters 
being  generally  on  the  south  side  of  the 
nave.  The  beautiful  porch  of  the  Angel 
Choir  of  Lincoln,  however,  is  south;  and 
there  the  cloisters  are  north,  as  at  Gloucester 
and  Chester.  Probably,  also,  the  desire  of 
protection  from  the  north  wind  caused 
many  of  the  deepest  porches  to  be  on  that 
side.  Not  a  few  of  the  great  cathedrals 
have  no  porch  on  either  side  of  the  nave. 
The  finest  north  ones  are  at  Salisbury, 
Worcester,  Wells,  Hereford,  and  Beverley ; 
and  many  large  parish  churches  have 
them.  At  Canterbury  alone  the  porch 
comes  out  of  the  south-west  tower. 
Generally  they  are  one  or  more  bays  from 
the  west.  They  often  have  chambers, 
called  "  parvises,"  over  them,  even  in  parish 
churches.  We  have  very  few  projecting 
porches  from  our  west  fronts  or  transept 
fronts.  The  Galilee  of  Ely  is  the  largest 
western  one,' unless  the  magnificent  three 
E.E.  arches  at  the  west  of  the  Norman  nave 
of  Peterborough  are  regardedas  a  triple  porch. 
Next  to  them  come  the  triple  west  porches 
of  St.  Alban's,  and  the  somewhat  similar 


®  POSITIVISTS 

ones  of  the  north  transept  of  Westminster 
Abbey.  The  French  cathedrals  generally 
beat  ours  considerably  in  triple  porches  on 
all  their  fronts,  which  was  facilitated  by 
their  great  height.     [Gr.] 

POSITIVISTS.  Those  who  assert  that 
nothing  is  to  be  accepted  as  truth,  except 
that  which  can  be  positively  proved  to 
human  reason  without  room  for  doubt. 
Though  this  theory  may  be  traced  in  previous 
works,  especially  in  the  school  of  Voltaire, 
and  the  Encyclopasdists,  it  is  to  Auguste 
Comte  that  we  must  refer  the  definite 
explanation — if  it  can  be  so  called — of  this 
school  of  thought.  He,  when  only  twenty 
years  of  age,  wrote  an  exposition  of  the  Poli- 
tique Positive  oith.e  Saint-Simonian  Society; 
and  when  Simon  died,  in  1825,  he  proceeded 
to  formulate  his  own  ideas  into  a  system. 
The  strain  on  his  mind  was  such  that  he 
became  insane,  and  for  a  time  was  under 
restraint ;  but  in  1832  he  had  recovered 
sufficiently  to  be  appointed  professor  of 
mathematics  at  the  Polytechnic  School  at 
Paris.  He  did  not  lead  a  moral  life,  and 
quarrelled  with  the  other  professors,  and  died 
in  September,  1857.  Comte's  theory  of  Posi- 
tivism has  been  called  "the  religion  of 
humanity,"  and  his  disciples  assert  that  it  is 
the  only  system  which  can  be  reconciled 
with  high  intellectual  development.  But  it 
consists  only  of  negations  with  regard  to 
Christianity,  and  indeed  all  religion  except 
the  worship  of  Humanity,  the  "  Ego  " ;  every 
person  being  to  himself  the  "  fitre  Suprgme  " 
of  his  religion.  A  revelation  from  God  is 
of  course  discarded ;  prayer  is  not  necessary, 
but,  as  a  substitute, "  eflusion  "  or  "  reverie  " 
is  advised :  the  idea  of  "  Resurrection  "  is 
brought  down  to  "  living  in  the  remembrance 
of  survivors."  This  naturally  leads  to 
Materialism  and  Fatalism,  as  is  shown  by 
Lecky  (Hist,  of  Rationalism,  ii.  408,  n.). 
The  Agnostics  of  the  present  day  are  really 
Positivists  holding  the  ideas  of  Comte 
with  some  variations  of  their  own.  The 
professed  Positivists  in  England  are  under- 
stood to  be  very  few,  while  Agnostics  of 
various  kinds  are  numerous.  The  etymology 
of  the  term  (from  a  and  yvoMTis)  merely 
implies,  that  they  say  "  we  know  not "  to 
all  propositions  of  religion.  The  bishop  of 
Derry  (Dr.  Alexander),  in  a  sermon  preached 
before  the  University  of  Oxford,  spoke  of 
the  term  Agnostic  as  one  sounding  better 
in  Greek  than  its  equivalent  in  Latin, 
"  ignoramus  "  (See  Comte's  Cours  de  Phil. 
Pos. ;  Lewis'  Exposition  of  Princ.  of  Pas. 
Phil).     [H.] 

POSTILS.  A  name  anciently  given  to 
sermons  or  homilies.  The  name  sprang 
from  the  fact  that  these  were  usually  de- 
livered immediately  after  reading  of  the 
Gospel    (quasi  post    ilia,   sc.   Eva/ngelia). 


PR.S}MUNIEE 


593 


Also,  in  printed  expositions  of  Scripture, 
from  the  text  being  first  exhibited,  and  post 
ilia  (after  the  words  of  the  text)  the  ex- 
plication of  the  writer. 

POSTURES  OP  DEVOTION  (See 
Kneeling ;   Genuflexion). 

PR^MUNIRE,  in  law,  is  either  taken 
for  a  form  of  writ,  or  for  the  offence  whereon 
the  writ  of  Pra3munire  is  granted.  It  origin- 
ated in  the  resolution  to  restrain  the  exorbi- 
tant power  claimed  and  exercised  in  England 
by  the  pope.  The  name  is  derived  from  the 
words  of  the  writ : — ■"■  Rex  vice-comiti,  &c. 
PraBmunire  facias  prajfatum  A.  B.  quod  tunc 
sit  coram  nobis,"  &c.  The  first  statute  of 
Prajmuniro  was  enacted  in  1353  (27  Edw. 
III.  c.  1).  In  this  the  grievance  was  stated, 
that  "  diverse  of  the  people  had  been  drawn 
out  of  the  realm  to  answer  to  things  whereof 
that  cognizance  pertaineth  to  the  King's 
Court ;  and  also  that  the  judgments  given  in 
the  said  Court  are  impeached  in  another 
Court  to  prejudice  and  dis-inherison  of  our 
lord  the  king,  and  of  all  the  people  of  the 
said  realm,  and  to  the  destruction  and 
undoing  of  the  common  law  of  the  said 
realm  at  all  times  used."  Those  who  trans- 
gressed, and  appealed  to  the  tribunal  of 
Rome,  were  subjected  to  very  heavy  penal- 
ties ;  rheir  property  was  forfeited,  and  they 
were  to  be  imprisoned.  By  the  statute  12 
Ric.  II.  c.  15,  all  liegemen  of  the  king 
accepting  of  a  living  by  any  foreign  pro- 
vision are  put  out  of  the  king's  protection, 
and  the  benefice  made  void.  Next  year  it 
was  enacted  "  that  any  person  bringing  over 
any  citation  or  exconmiunication  from  be- 
yond sea,  shall  be  imprisoned,  and  forfeit 
his  goods,"  &c.  (13  Ric.  IL  st.  2,  cc.  2,  3). 
But  the  statute  which  goes  by  the  name  of 
the  "  Statute  of  Prajmunire,"  and  which  is 
generally  referred  to  by  all  subsequent  sta- 
tutes, is  that  of  16  Ric.  II.  c.  5,  which  forbids, 
under  heavy  penalties,  any  translations, 
processes,  excommunications,  bulls,  &c., 
which  touch  the  king — against  him,  his 
crown  and  realm — ^being  brought  into  or 
observed  in  the  kingdom.  The  pope,  how- 
ever, still  endeavoured  to  exercise  this 
power ;  and  so,  by  2  Hen.  IV.  c.  3,  it  was 
enacted  that  all  persons  who  accepted  any 
provision  from  the  pope  to  be  exempt  from 
canonical  obedience  to  their  proper  ordinary, 
were  to  be  subjected  to  the  penalties  of 
Prajmunire.  The  popes  afterwards,  and 
especially  Martin  V.,  endeavoured  to  get 
this  Statute  of  Prajmunire — illvd  execraMle 
statutum,  as  the  latter  called  it — repealed, but 
in  vain  (See  Wilkins'  Concil.  Magn.  Prit, 
vol.  iii.).  Originally,  therefore,  the  penalties 
of  prasmunire  were  kept  within  the  bounds 
of  their  original  institution — that  of  check- 
ing the  power  of  the  pope  ;  but  they  have 
since  been  applied  to  other  matters,  one  of 

2  Q 


.59i 


PEAGMATIC  SANCTION 


which  need  only  be  mentioned  here.  The 
'statute  of  25  Hen.  yill.  c.  20  enacts,  that 
if  the  dean  and  chapter  refuse  to  elect  the 
25erson  nominated  by  the  king  to  a  vacant 
bishopric,  or  if  any  archbishop  or  bishop 
refuse  to  confirm  or  consecrate  him,  they 
shall  incur  the  penalties  of  the  statutes  of 
the  Prjemunire  mentioned  above. — Stephen's 
Blackstmie,  iv.  251.  seq. ;  Milman's  Hist. 
Lat.  aiirist.  v.  484 :  vi.  79 ;  Hook's  Arcli- 
Ushop's,  iv.  147,  189 :  vi.  393. 

PRAGMATIC  SANCTION  (wpay^, 
husiness).  An  edict  or  decree  of  the  sove- 
reign upon  weighty  matters  or  business. 
Iteferring  to  the  expression  historically, 
the  earliest  Pragmatic  Sanction  on  record  is 
that  drawn  up  by  Louis  IX.,  king  of  France, 
in  1268,  against  the  encroachments  of  the 
Church  and  Court  of  Home.  It  limited  the 
interference  of  the  Court  of  Rome  in  the 
elections  of  the  bishops  and  clergy,  and 
directly  denied  its  right  of  ecclesiastical 
taxation.  It  was  superseded  in  1438  by 
the  Pragmatic  Sanction  of  Charles  VII., 
which  was  drawn  up  at  Bourges.  This 
having  re-asserted  the  rights  and  privileges 
claimed  for  the  Galilean  Church  under 
Louis  IX.,  it  accorded  with  the  Council  of 
Basle,  at  that  time  sitting,  in  maintaining 
that  a  general  council  is  independent  of  the 
pope,  and  in  asserting  that  all  papal  bulls 
should  be  null  and  void  unless  they  received 
the  consent  of  the  king.  It  withheld  also 
the  payment  of  annates  (See  Annates). 
Pope  Pius  II.  succeeded  in  obtaining  the 
abrogation  of  this  sanction  for  a  time.  But 
the  Parlianient  of  Paris  refused  to  approve 
the  conduct  of  Louis  XL  in  setting  it  aside, 
and  he  was  compelled  to  restore  it  to  its 
original  influential  position.  It  accordingly 
remained  in  full  force  up  to  the  year  1517, 
when  it  was  supplanted  by  the  concordat 
of  Bologna,  which  was  agreed  upon  between 
Francis  I.  and  Pope  Julius  II.  Although  by 
the  concordat  privileges  were  given  and  re- 
ceived on  both  sides,  yet  the  real  advantages 
were  on  the  side  of  Rome ;  which  advantages 
it  has  ever  since  been  her  constant  aim  to 
improve.  ■ — •  Sismondi,  viii.  104 ;  Hallam, 
Middle  Ages,  ii.  214,  225;  Milman's  Lat. 
Christ,  iv.  440  :  vi.  117,  216. 

PRAISE.  A  reverent  acknowledgment 
of  the  perfections  of  God,  and  of  the  bless- 
ings flowing  from  them  to  mankind,  usually 
expressed  in  hymns  of  gratitude  and  thanks- 
giving, and  especially  in  the  reception  of 
the  holy  Eucharist — that  "sacrifice  of  praise, 
and  sublimest  token  of  our  joy  "  (See  ^zt- 
charist). 

PRAXBANISTS  (See  Patripassians). 

PRAYER.  A  word  of  the  same  family 
as  Ar. 'n'!!?,  iarak,  to  bless;  and  preach: 
Lat.  prewr,  Fr.  prier.  It  is  allied,  per- 
haps,   with    Sax.   prsignan,   Ger.  fragen. 


PRAYER  BOOK 

The  offering-up  of  our  desires  to  God  for 
things  agreeable  to  His  will,  in  the  name  of 
Christ,  by  the  aid  of  His  Spirit,  with  con- 
fession of  our  sins,  and  thankful  acknow- 
ledgment of  His  mercies.  The  necessity  of 
prayer  is  so  universally  acknowledged  by  all 
who  profess  and  call  themselves  Christians, 
and  so  clearly  enjoined  in  Scripture,  that  to 
insist  ujMn  this  duty — this  sacred  and 
pleasant  exercise  to  the  renewed  in  heart — 
is  unnecessary.  Prayer  is  either  private  or 
public,  and  it  implies  faith  in  the  particular 
providence  of  God.  The  general  providence 
of  God  acts  through  what  are  called  the 
laws  of  nature.  By  His  particular  providence 
God  interferes  with  those  laws,  and  He  hath 
promised  to  interfere  in  behalf  of  those  who 
pray  in  the  name  of  Jesus.  As  we  are  to 
shape  our  labom-s  by  ascertaining,  through 
the  circumstances  under  which  we  are  pro- 
videntially placed,  what  is  the  will  of  G«i 
with  reference  to  ourselves;  as,  for  example, 
the  husbandman,  the  professional  man,  the 
prince,  all  labour  for  different  things  placed 
within  their  reach,  and  do  not  labour  for 
that  which  God  evidently  does  not  design 
for  them ;  so  we  are  to  regulate  our  prayers, 
and  we  may  take  it  as  a  general  rule,  that 
we  may  pray  for  that  for  which  we  may 
lawfully  labour,  and  for  that  only.  And 
when  we  pray  for  what  is  requisite  and 
necessary  for  the  body  or  the  soul,  we  are  at 
the  same  time  to  exert  ourselves.  Prayer 
without  exertion  is  a  mockery  of  God,  as 
exertion  without  prayer  is  presumption. 
The  general  providence  of  God  requires  that 
we  should  exert  ourselves,  the  particular 
providence  of  God  that  we  should  pray. 

PRAYERS  FOR  THE  DEAD.  It  was 
decided  by  Sir  Herbert  Jenner,  in  Breehs  v. 
Woolfrey,  1838  (Ecc.  Judgments,  350),  that 
an  epitaph,  "  Pray  for  the  soul  of  J.  W.,"  on 
a  tombstone  in  a  churchyard  was  not  un- 
lawful ;  although  prayers  for  the  dead  were 
dropped  out  of  the  Prayer  Book  between  the 
first  and  second  books  of  Edward  VI.,  and 
never  restored.  He  held  that  there  is  no 
positive  prohibition  of  them  in  the  22nd 
Article  against  Purgatory,  or  in  any  Canon, 
though  the  Homilies  certainly  disapproved 
of  them ;  and  therefore,  that  the  Court  could 
not  interfere  with  an  epitaph  of  that  kind. 
The  using  of  such  a  prayer  in  church  would 
of  course  be  unlawful,  as  only  those  of  the 
Prayer  Book,  or  the  Bible,  by  the  Acts  of 
Uniformity  can  lawfully  be  used  there  (see 
Public  Worship').  The  text  from  2  Mac.  xii. 
46,  was  hardly  relied  on,  inasmuch  as  the 
6th  Article  says  that  "  the  Church  doth  not 
apply  the  books  of  the  Apocrypha  to  establish 
any  doctrine."     [G.] 

PRATER  BOOK,  THE.  The  Book  of 
Common  Prayer  and  Administration  of  the 
Sacraments,  and  other  rites  and  ceremonies 


PKAYER  BOOK 

■according  to  the  use  of  the  Church  of 
England,  together  with  the  Psalter  or 
Psahns  of  David,  pointed  as  they  are  to  be 
sung  or  said  in  churches ;  and  the  form  and 
manner  of  making,  ordaining,  and  conse- 
crating of  hishops,  priests,  and  deacons 
{See  also  Liturgy). 

The  Prayer  Book  now  in  use  in  the 
Church  in  England  and,  translated  into  other 
tongues,  in  many  other  countries,  can  only 
be  duly  understood  by  a  careful  study  of 
its  history.  It  is  a  compound  work,  partly 
translated  from  service  books  and  forms 
traceable  to  apostolic  times,  partly  taken 
from  Holy  Scripture,  and  partly  consist- 
ing, though  in  a  less  degree,  of  original 
matter.  Until  the  second  year  of  Edward 
YI.'s  reign  the  Church  Services  were  all  in 
Latin,  the  language  of  the  Western  Church 
and  that  in  which  every  important  docu- 
ment was  couched.  It  was  "  a  tongue  not 
understanded  of  the  people,"  but  yet  they 
were  not  so  completely  in  the  dark  as  is 
■commonly  supposed.  Translations  of  the 
Lord's  Prayer  and  the  Creeds  are  of  early 
•date.  "  Horn  books  "  in  English  existed  for 
the  poor,  and,  for  those  who  could  purchase  a 
book,  there  were  "  Prymers,"  containing  the 
greater  part  of  the  Psalms,  tlie  Canticles, 
the  Creed,  Lord's  Prayer,  Litany,  and  many 
prayers  and  anthems  in  the  14th  century 
i(See  Horn  Boohs ;  Prymer). 

The  Latin  service  books  were — the  Bre- 
^ary,  containing  the  daily  services  for  the 
Hours ;  the  Missal,  containing  the  office  for 
Holy  Communion  with  the  Epistles  and 
■Gospels  ;  the  Manual,  containing  the  oiEces 
for  Baptism,  Visitation  of  the  Sick,  Marriage, 
Burial  of  the  Dead ;  the  Pontifical,  contain- 
ing the  Ordination  and  Consecration  services ; 
the  order  of  Coronation  existed  in  a 
separate  book  ( "  Liber  Eegalis,  seu  Ordo 
■Consecrandi  Regem  solum,  seu  0.  C.  Eegi- 
Toam  cimi  Eege,  seu  O.  C.  Eeginam  solam. 
Rubrica  de  Eegiis  exequiis,"  date,  circa 
1380).  The  outward  form  of  the  coronation 
■of  a  sovereign  remained  essentially  unaltered 
in  England  from  the  time  of  Ethelred  to 
that  of  George  IV.  In  the  reign  of  Henry 
VIII.  some  small  changes  were  made  in  the 
Latin  office  books,  such  as  the  erasure  of 
-certain  collects  for  the  Pope,  of  the  office 
of  Thomas  k  Becket,  and  of  some  other 
saints,  whose  days  by  the  king's  injunc- 
tion were  no  more  to  be  observed.  But 
these  changes  were  so  few  that  no  new 
■office  books  were  required.  A  committee 
■of  convocation  was  appointed  in  1542,  con- 
sisting of  the  bishops  of  Salisbmy  (Shaxton) 
and  Ely  (Goodrich)  and  six  clergy  of  the 
.lower  house,  to  examine  the  service  books 
preparatory  to  a  thorough  revision. 

During  this  examination  it  became  evi- 
dent that   the   adoption    of    the    English 


PRAYER  BOOK 


695 


tongue  instead  of  the  Latin  would  be  a 
necessity.  The  change,  however,  was  a 
more  gradual  one  than  is  often  supposed. 
The  Litany  had  been  for  many  generations 
used  in  English,  and  was  therefore  perfectly 
familiar  when  authorised  for  public  use  in 
1544  (See  Litany).  In  1547,  the  first  year 
of  Edward  VL,  "an  order  of  Communion" 
draivn  up  by  Archbishop  Cranmer,  approved 
by  convocation,  and  ratified  by  parliament, 
was  issued  by  proclamation  from  the  Crown. 
It  provided,  in  addition  to  and  expressly 
without  variation  from  the  ancient  Salisbury 
Mass,  a  form  of  communion  in  both  kinds  for 
the  laity,  consisting  of  the  "  Dearly  Beloved 
in  the  Lord,  ye  that  mind,"  replacing  an 
exhortation  referring  to  communion  in  one 
kind,  "Ye  that  do  tmly,"  confession, 
absolution,  comfortable  words,  and  prayer 
of  "  Humble  access ;  "  then  the  first  sentence 
of  the  sentences  of  administration  now 
used,  and  the  blessing.  This  addition  to 
the  Salisbury  Mass  was  employed  when  any 
of  the  laity  wished  to  communicate.  A 
new  and  enlarged  committee  of  convocation 
then  sat,  taking  as  the  basis  of  their  work 
the  labours  of  the  past  committee  in  the 
same  field.     Their  names  were : — 

1.  Thomas  Cranmer,  archbishop  of  Can- 
terbury. 

2.  Thomas  Goodrich,  bishop  of  Ely. 

3.  Henry  Holbech,  bishop  of  Lincoln. 

4.  George  Day,  bishop  of  Chichester. 

5.  John  Skip,  bishop  of  Hereford. 

6.  Thomas  Thirlby,  bishop  of  Westmin- 
ster. 

7.  Nicholas  Ridley,  bishop  of  Rochester, 
and  afterwards  of  London. 

8.  Dr.  Wilham  May,  dean  of  St.  Paul's. 

9.  Dr.  John  Taylor,  dean,  afterwards 
bishop,  of  Lincoln. 

10.  Dr.  Simon  Haynes,  dean  of  Exeter, 
and  master  of  Queen's  College,  Cambridge. 

11.  Dr.  John  Redmayne,  prebendary  of 
Westminster,  and  master  of  Trinity  College, 
Cambridge. 

12.  Dr.  Richard  Cox,  dean  of  Christ 
Church,  Oxford,  afterwards  bishop  of  Ely. 

Of  their  method  of  work  no  record  has 
come  down  to  us,  nor  is  it  possible  to  assign 
to  any  of  the  writers  a  specific  portion. 
Their  task  included  the  restoration  of  the  due 
andthorough  reading  of  the  Holy  Scriptures, 
which  had  by  the  introduction  of  foreign 
matter,  as  stories,  and  legends,  become  so 
broken  that  when  any  book  of  the  Bible  was 
begun,  after  tliree  or  four  chapters  were 
read  out,  the  rest  were  unread. 

This  was  remedied  by  a  calendar  of  lessons, 
wbicb,  with  the  exception  of  the  moveable 
feasts,  had  no  proper  lessons,  but  continued 
in  an  unbroken  course. 

The  omissions  from  the  book  of  the  short 
passages  foiTuerly  used  as  lessons  rendered 

2  Q  2 


596 


PEAYEE  BOOK 


it  possible  to  comlDine  in  one  volume  tte 
office  of  Holy  Communion,  the  daily,  and  the 
occasional  services.  A  further  step  towards 
rendering  the  service  more  simple  was  taken 
when  it  was  arranged  that  in  the  daily 
service  only  the  Psalms  and  lessons  should 
vary  daily,  and  the  first  collect  weekly. 

The  eight  services  belonging  to  the  eight 
hours  of  prayer,  which  had  very  generally 
come  to  be  repeated  in  immediate  succession 
to  each  other,  involving  constant  repetition 
of  prayers  and  versicles,  were  recast  into  the 
two  services  of  mattins  and  evensong. 

The  book,  which  bore  the  same  title  as  the 
present  one,  except  that  it  ends  at  the  words 
"Church  of  England,"  contained — 

1.  The  Preface, .  identical  with  "  Con- 
cerning the  Service  of  the  Church"  in 
the  present  book,  except  that  it  does  not 
mention  a  further  reference  to  the  arch- 
bishop, and  that  with  respect  to  mattins  and 
evensong  the  direction  is,  "  Neither  that 
any  man  shall  be  bound  to  the  saying  of 
them,  but  such  as  from  time  to  time  in 
cathedral  and  collegiate  chm'ches,  parish 
churches  and  chapels  to  the  same  annexed, 
shall  serve  the  congregation."  Nor  is  there 
any  direction  for  tolling  the  bell. 

2.  The  table  and  calendar  of  the  Psalms 
and  Lessons. 

3.  The  order  for  mattins  and  evensong 
beginning  with  the  Lord's  Prayer,  and  end- 
ing with  the  third  collect  without  the  alter- 
native Psalms.  (Pss.  c,  xcviii.,  and  Ixvii.). 
Included  under  the  same  heading  is  the 
Athanasian  Creed  ordered  at  Christmas, 
Epiphany,  Ascension,  Pentecost,  and  Trinity 
Sunday. 

4.  The  Introits,  i.e.  a  special  psahn  for 
each  Smiday  and  Festival,  the  collects, 
epistles  and  gospels  used  at  Holy  Commu- 
nion, including  one  for  St.  Mary  Magdalene's 
Day,  and  without  mention  of  the  6  th  Sunday 
after  Easter,  certain  proper  psalms  and 
lessons. 

5.  The  supper  of  the  Lord,  commonly 
called  the  Mass  (see  Liturgy),  with  the 
direction  to  the  priest  to  wear  a  white  albe, 
plain,  with  a  vestment  or  cope,  and  the 
assistant  priests  albes  with  tunicles.  The 
service  opens  with  the  collect  for  Purity, 
followed  by  the  Introit  Psalm,  the  Kyrie, 
Gloria  in  Excelsis,  prayer  for  the  King, 
collect,  epistle  and  gospel,  two  exhortations 
to  be  used  in  the  priest's  discretion,  offertory 
sentences,  "Lift  up  your  hearts,"  Proper 
Prefaces,  Church  Militant,  Prayer  down  to 
"  other  adversity  "  when  it  passes  into  a  com- 
memoration of  the  saints,  and  prayer  for  the 
faithful  departed,  the  prayer  of  Consecration 
containing  the  Invocation  of  the  Holy  Ghost. 
Then  another  prayer  from  which  our  present 
first  post-communion  collect  is  taken,  the 
Lord's  Prayer,  a  versicle  and  response.     Con- 


PEAYEE  BOOK 

fession,  absolution,  the  comfortable  words, 
prayer  of  humble  access,  the  administration 
(with  the  first  half  only  of  our  present  form)i 
"Agnus  Dei,"  certain  sentences  of  Holy 
Scripture,  a  versicle  and  response,  collect 
("  Almighty  and  overliving  God),"  and  the 
blessing.  The  occasional  collects,  and 
those  for  rain  and  for  fair  weather,  are  printed 
at  the  end. 

6.  The  Litany,  containing  a  prayer  for  a 
"  deliverance  from  the  tyranny  of  the  bishop 
of  Home  and  his  detestable  enormities." 

7.  Administration  of  Public  Baptism,  of 
which  the  special  difference  from  the  present 
office  was  the  exorcism  of  the  unclean  spirit 
in  the  church  porch,  the  introduction  of  the 
child  into  the  church,  the  putting  on  a 
white  garment  called  the  Chrism  after  bap- 
tism, and  the  subsequent  anointing  on  the 
forehead  with  oil. 

8.  Private  Baptism  is  substantially  the 
same  with  the  jiresent  office,  except  for  the 
solemn  putting  on  of  the  Chrism.  In  this 
office  also  is  included  one  for  the  benediction 
of  the  water  in  the  font  whenever  changed. 

9.  Confirmation  (including  the  catechism 
to  the  end  of  the  "  I  desire  my  Lord  God  "), 
unction  with  the  sign  of  the  cross  at  the 
laying  on  of  hands,  and  the  use  of  the 
Christian  name. 

10.  Office  of  Matrimony,  differing  in  few 
points  from  the  present  office. 

11.  Yisitation  of  the  Sick,  opening  with 
Psalm  cxliii.,  containing  a  solemn  anointing, 
and  closing  with  Ps.  xiii. 

12.  The  Communion  of  the  Sick,  contain- 
ing the  direction  to  the  priest  to  reserve  the- 
previous  "  open  communion  "  in  church,  so 
much  of  the  Sacrament  of  the  Body  andi 
Blood,  as  shall  serve  the  sick  person,  and  so. 
many  as  shall  communicate  with  him  (if 
there  be  any)  to  recite  the  Confession,  Abso- 
lution, and  the  Comfortable  Words,  then  to- 
administer  the  reserved  Sacrament,  and  end 
the  service  with  the  collect,  "  Almighty  and 
everliving  God."  Provision  is  also  made  for 
a  communion  "  afore  noon  "  in  the  sick  man's- 
house,  differing  in  few  particulars  from  the 
present  order,  except  in  a  jirovision  for  the- 
reservation  of  the  Sacrament  for  other  sick, 
and  for  unction  if  desired. 

13.  The  order  for  the  Burial  of  the  Dead, 
differing  somewhat  in  the  order  of  the  pray- 
ers from  the  present  office,  and  containing  a 
special  commendation  of  the  soul  to  God,  the 
body  to  the  ground — a  prayer  for  the  souls 
of  aU  the  elect.  Psalms  cx-vi.,  cxxxix.,  cxM. 
— a  prayer  for  the  forgiveness  of  the  sins  of 
the  departed  soul,  and  that  he  may  "  receive 
this  body  again  to  glory,  then  made  pure 
and  incomiptible." 

For  the  Holy  Communion  at  a  burial,  the- 
service  opens  with  Psalm  xlii.,  the  collect 
("  0  merciful  God,  the  Father  of  our  Lord 


PRAYER  BOOK 

Jesus  Christ "),  Epistle,  1  Thess.  Iv.,  Gospel, 
St.  John  vi.  37-41. 

14.  The  order  for  the  Purification  of 
Women,  where  the  ruhric  directs  her  to 
kneel  "  nigh  unto  the  quire  door,"  and  the 
Psalm  is  the  cxxi.,  and  the  direction  to 
her  is  to  "  offer  her  chrism." 

15.  The  first  day  of  Lent,  commonly 
called  Ash-Wednesday,  is  the  same  service 
with  that  called  Commination  in  the  present 
Prayer  Book,  except  for  a  few  verhal  differ- 
ences and  the  absence  of  the  Blessing. 

"  Of  Ceremonies,  Why  some  be  abolished 
and  some  retained,"  comes  at  the  end  of  the 
book  instead  of  in  its  present  place,  and 
also  some  "  Notes  "  (1)  as  to  the  use  of  a  sur- 
plice at  "  mattins  and  evensong,  baptizing, 
and  burying,"  by  the  minister,  the  wearing  of 
such  hoods  as  pertain  to  their  degi-ee.  (2) 
The  bishop's  vestments  in  celebrating  the 
Holy  Communion  to  be  beside  his  rochette, 
a  surplice  or  albe,  and  a  cope  or  vestment, 
and  also  his  pastoral  staff  in  his  hand,  or  else 
borne  by  his  chaplain.  (3)  Gestures  of 
private  devotion,  which  may  be  used  or  left. 
^4)  The  permission  to  use  at  Christmas, 
Easter,  Ascension,  Whitsunday,  and  feast 
of  Trinity  a  portion  of  Holy  Scripture  to  be 
hereinafter  certainly  limited  and  appointed 
E-nstead  of  the  Litany.  (5)  A  discretion 
to  the  curate  to  omit  for  a  sermon  or  great 
cause  the  Litany,  Gloria  in  Excelsis,  Creed, 
bomily,  and  exhortation  to  communion. 

The  book  has  been  described  in  some  de- 
tail because  of  the  great  importance  attach- 
ing to  this,  the  first  Book  of  Common  Prayer 
ia  England-  Before  1549  a  diversity  of 
Uses  had^prevailed.  The  "  Uses  "  of  Sarum, 
York,  Hereford,  Bangor,  and  Lincoln  were 
Jill  extant,  of  which  the  Use  of  Sarum  is  the 
best  known,  and  the  one  which  most  influ- 
enced the  Prayer  Book.  By  the  first  Prayer 
Book  these  were  condensed  and  combined 
in  one,  the  rough  translations  already  written 
polished,  and  the  whole  put  into  the  best 
and  clearest  English  of  the  time.  With 
the  single  exception  of  the  reference  in  the 
Litany  to  the  Bishop  of  Eome,  the  Book 
soars  far  above  all  controversy,  and  shows  a 
remarkable  regard  for  Holy  Scripture,  and 
for  the  preservation  of  all  that  belonged  to 
genuine  Church  tradition.  That  an  enor- 
mous accretion  was  removed  is  intimated  in 
the  preface  to  this  book,  and  the  treatise 
"  Of  Ceremonies,"  and  the  highly  complex 
system  which  was  the  cause  that  "  to  turn 
the  book  only  was  so  hard  and  intricate  a 
matter,  that  many  times  there  was  more 
business  to  find  out  what  should  be  read 
tiian  to  read  it  when  it  was  found  out,"  was 
reduced  to  a  more  simple  one. 

The  exclusive  use  of  this  book  was  en- 
acted by  the  first  Act  of  Uniformity  of  2  &  3 
Edw.  VL ;  a  subsequent  Act,  3  &  4  Edw. 


PRAYER  BOOK 


597 


VL,  called  in  all  other  books  soever  hereto- 
fore used  in  the  service  of  the  Church, 
whether  in  English  or  Latin,  saving  the 
primers  set  forth  by  King  Henry  VIII.,  if 
the  prayers  to  Saints  be  blotted  out.  Seven 
editions  of  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer 
were  printed,  differing  very  slightly,  and  it 
came  into  use  at  Whitsuntide,  June  9, 1549. 
During  the  same  year  the  Ordinal  was  pub- 
lished as  a  separate  book  (See  Ordination). 

Contemporary  evidence  shows  that  the 
book  was  accepted  with  satisfaction  by  the 
majority  of  the  clergy  and  laity.  The 
foreign  reformers  were  less  satisfied,  and  as 
three  of  them,  Eagius,  Bucer,  and  Peter 
Martyr,  had  professorships,  the  two  former 
at  Cambridge,  the  latter  at  Oxford,  their 
influence  was  greater  than  it  would  otherwise 
have  been.  Calvin  also  busied  himself 
much  in  the  matter,  and  aroused  so  strong  a 
wish  for  change  in  the  king's  mind  that  he 
threatened  to  change  the  book  on  his  own 
authority.  The  book  was,  apparently  for 
peace  sake,  submitted  to  a  revision  by  the 
bishops.  The  principal  changes  made  were 
the  addition  of  the  sentences,  exhortation, 
confession  and  absolution  at  mattins  and 
evensong  ;  the  removal  of  the  introits  from 
the  Communion  office,  and  the  insertion  of 
the  Commandments  instead;  the  omission 
of  the  Invocation  of  the  Holy  Ghost  in  the 
Prayer  of  Consecration,  and  other  changes 
made  the  bringing  that  office  to  its  present 
form,  with  the  exception  of  the  words  of 
Administration,  which  now  began  "Take 
and  eat,"  "  Drink  this,"  omitting  the  first 
part  of  the  present  sentences  entirely.  The 
rest  of  the  changes  consisted,  as  Collier 
says,  in  "discharging  several  rites  and 
parts  of  the  service  retained  in  the  former 
book."  The  office  of  Baptism  was  altered 
to  its  present  form.  The  sign  of  the  cross 
and  use  of  oil  omitted  from  the  Confir- 
mation service,  and  the  prayer  "  Defend,  0 
Lord,"  took  their  place.  Prayers  for  the 
departed  were  omitted  from  the  Communion 
service,  and  from  that  for  the  Burial  of  the 
Dead,  which  also  lost  its  special  introit. 
Epistle  and  Gospel,  and  the  provision  for  a 
funeral  celebration  of  Holy  Communion. 
The  unction  of  the  sick  was  also  omitted. 
Some  changes  were  made  in  the  rubrics, 
substituting  "  table  "  for  altar,  "  north  side  " 
for  "  afore  the  altar,"  and  forbidding  the  use 
of  albe,  vestment,  or  cope. 

These  alterations  were,  by  the  second  Act 
of  Uniformity,  5  &  6  Edw.  VI.  c.  1,  said  to 
be  made  "  as  well  for  the  more  plain  and 
manifest  explanation  thereof  "  ("  the  use  and 
exercise  of  common  service  in  the  church  ") 
"  as  for  the  more  perfection  of  the  said  order 
of  common  service."  This  Act  also  includes 
the  Ordinal  as  "  of  like  force,  authority  and 
value,"  with  the  Prayer  Book.    This  book 


598 


PEAYEK  BOOK 


was  published  in  1552,  to  come  into  use  on 
All  Saints'  Day  in  that  year.  The  rubric 
known  as  the  "  Declaration  on  kneeling  " 
formed  no  part  of  the  book  when  confirmed  by 
the  Act  of  Parliament,  but  was  printed  six 
months  later,  and  inserted  in  a  separate  leaf 
in  the  copies  already  circulated.  It  would 
seem  from  the  wording  of  the  Act  that  the 
revisers  considered  their  alterations  to  be 
matters  of  small  moment,  and  were  hardly 
aware  how  considerable  a  change  they  had 
made, — a  change  the  more  to  be  regretted, 
as  it  proved  to  be  needless.  The  second 
Prayer  Book  came  into  use  November  1, 
1552.  King  Edward  died  July  6,  1553, 
and  his  successor,  Queen  Mary,  repealed  the 
Acts  of  Uniformity  and  abolished  the  Prayer 
Book  in  the  October  of  the  same  year. 
She  called  in  Henry  VII.'s  erased  books, 
and  enacted  that  the  service  should  stand 
as  it  most  commonly  did  in  the  last  year  of 
Henry  VIH.  In  1558  Queen  Elizabeth 
came  to  the  throne,  and  for  more  than  a 
month  no  change  in  the  service  was  made, 
except  that  elevation  of  the  Host  was  for- 
bidden, but  on  December  27,  by  royal  pro- 
clamation all  preaching  or  teaching  was  for- 
bidden other  than  the  Gospels  and  Epistles 
of  the  day,  and  the  Ten  Commandments  in 
the  vulgar  tongue,  and  also  any  service  but 
that  actually  in  use,  or  the  Litany  and  the 
Lord's  Prayer  and  Creed  in  English.  In 
the  paiise  thus  obtained  the  question  was 
discussed  by  a  cominittee  of  divines  which 
of  the  two  service  books  should  be  restored 
to  use.  They  finally  made  choice  of  the 
second  book,  with  certain  alterations,  the 
most  important  of  which  were:  1.  A  table 
of  proper  lessons  for  Sundays;  2.  The 
"accustomed  place,"  or  chancel,  instead  of 
"  in  such  place  as  the  people  may  best 
hear,"  was  appointed  for  the  celebration  of 
Divine  Service;  3.  The  ornaments  of  the 
church  and  ministers  were  to  be  restored 
as  under  the  2nd  year  of  King  Edward  VI. ; 
until  other  order  should  be  taken  in  the 
manner  provided  by  the  Act  (see  Adver- 
tisements) ;  4.  The  clause  in  the  Litany  pray- 
ing for  deliverance  from  the  Bishop  of  Komo 
to  be  omitted ;  5.  The  present  form  of  ad- 
ministration of  the  Consecrated  Elements 
was  substituted  for  that  of  the  second 
book,  thus  combining  the  forms  of  both 
books ;  6.  The  declaration  on  kneeling  was 
wholly  omitted. 

In  this  form  the  book  was  annexed  to  a 
third  Act  of  Uniformity,  1  Eliz.  c.  2,  in  1559, 
and  came  into  use  on  June  24  of  the  same 
year.  There  is  this  remarkable  about  it,  that 
the  Komanists  all  accepted  it,  and  attended 
the  church  services  therein  provided  for  the 
ten  first  years  of  Elizabeth's  reign.  Pope 
Pius  IV.  allowed  that  both  the  Bible  and 
Prayer  Book  as  used  in  England  were  au- 


PEAYEE  BOOK 

thentic,  and  not  repugnant  to  truth,  and  he . 
offered  to  allow  the  service  book  unaltered  if 
Elizabeth  would  receive  it  from  him,  by  his 
allowance,  which  she  however  refused.  His 
successor,  Pius  V.,  excommunicated  her  in 
1570.  In  1563  the  Bible  and  Prayer  Book 
were  translated  into  Welsh.  Elizabeth's 
Prayer  Book  was  never  submitted  to  the 
Convocations,  in  which  the  Marian  bishops 
and  clergy  then  predominated. 

Except  a  revision  of  the  Calendar,  no 
further  changes  were  made  during  this  reign, 
but  the  use  of  the  book  was  very  far  from 
being  uniform,  either  as  to  ritual  or  the  use 
of  the  prayers.  Those  who  had  been  in  exile 
during  Mary's  reign  were  many  of  them  in 
favour  of  a  bare  church,  of  extemporary 
prayers,  and  of  sermons  as  the  chief  feature 
of  worship.  The  tradition  of  reverent  wor- 
ship, to  which  the  original  compilers  of  the 
first  book  had  trusted  so  much,  became  dim 
in  the  minds  of  the  people,  and  the  Puritan 
party  were  persistent  in  their  attacks.  lu 
1604,  a  conference  was  held  at  Hampton 
Court  before  James  I.,  to  hear  the  Puritan 
objections  to  the  Prayer  Book ;  he  broke  up 
the  meeting  on  the  thii-d  day,  and  gave 
directions  himself  to  the  archbishop  of  Can- 
terbury (Whitgift)  and  other  high  commis- 
sioners to  review  the  book.  It  appears  to  be 
very^questionable  whether  the  proviso  in  1 
Eliz.  c.  2,  under  which  he  acted,  gave  him 
any  such  power,  but  alterations  were  made. 
"  Or  remission  of  sins "  was  added  to  the 
title  of  the  Absolution,  the  prayer  for  the 
Royal  family  placed  at  the  end  of  the  Litany, 
some  minor  alterations  made  in  the  rubrics, 
"Lawful  minister"  being  inserted  in  the 
rubric  for  Private  Baptism;  certain  of  the 
"  Thanksgivings  on  special  occasions  "  were 
added,  also  the  part  of  the  Catechism  relat- 
ing to  the  Sacraments,  and  some  small 
changes  made  in  the  Calendar.  The  irregu- 
larities in  the  use  of  the  book  and  the 
ornaments  of  the  church  and  ministers 
continued  throughout  this  reign  as  well  as 
the  next,  and  were  winked  at  by  some  of 
the  bishops,  though  the  Visitation  articles 
of  others  prove  both  their  own  diligence  and 
the  great  necessity  that  existed  for  it.  On 
January  3, 1645,  the  parliament  passed,  with- 
out the  sanction  of  Charles  I.,  an  ordinance 
repealing  the  Acts  of  Uniformity  and  for- 
bidding the  use  of  the  Prayer  Book  in  any 
place  of  worship  in  England  or  Wales. 
On  August  23  of  the  same  year  (St.  Bar- 
tholomew's Eve)  the  private  use  of  it  was 
also  forbidden,  and  all  copies  required  to  be- 
given  up  by  the  same  authority. 

During  fifteen  years  the  service  of  the 
Church  could  only  be  said  under  heavy 
penalties,  generally  rigidly  enforced,  but  it 
was  never  entirely  discontinued,  though 
used  with  the  greatest  precautions  for  se- 


PRAYER  BOOK 

crecy.  At  the  Restoration  of  Charles  II.,  in 
1660,  copies  of  the  Prayer  Book  were  hastily 
reprinted,  without  even  the  needful  changes 
in  the  names  of  the  Eoyal  family,  and  the 
use  of  the  book  revived  more  rapidly  than 
might  have  been  expected,  one  of  the  first 
instances  being  the  burial  of  Dr.  Hammond 
with  the  proper  burial  service  on  April  26  of 
that  year.  In  the  Chapel  Royal  at  White- 
hall, when  the  Court  was  settled  there,  the 
Prayer  Book  was  at  once  restored.  By 
letters  patent,  King  Charles  called  a  confer- 
ence of  "  Learned  Divines  of  both  persua- 
sions "  to  "  review  the  Liturgy  of  the  Church 
of  England."     They  were  as  follows : — 

On  the  Church  side. 

Principals. 

1.  Dr.  Frewen,  archbishop  of  York.  2. 
Dr.  Sheldon,  bishop  of  London,  afterwards 
archbishop  of  Canterbury.  3.  Dr.  Cosin, 
bishop  of  Durham.  4.  Dr.  Warner,  bishop 
of  Rochester.  5.  Dr.  King,  bishop  of  Chi- 
chester. 6.  Dr.  Henchman,  bishop  of  Salis- 
bury, afterwards  of  London.  7.  Dr.  Morley, 
bishop  of  Worcester,  afterwards  of  Winches- 
ter. 8.  Dr.  Sanderson,  bishop  of  Lincoln. 
9.  Dr.  Laney,  bishop  of  Peterborough,  after- 
wards of  Lincoln  and  Ely.  10.  Dr.  Walton, 
bishop  of  Chester.  11.  Dr.  Stern,  bishop  of 
Carlisle,  afterwards  archbishop  of  York.  12. 
Dr.  Gauden,  bishop  of  Exeter,  afterwards  of 
Worcester. 

Coadjutors. 

1.  Dr."  John  Earle,  dean  of  Westminster, 
afterwards  bishop  of  Worcester.  2.  Dr.  Peter 
Heylyn,  prebendary  of  Westminster.  3.  Dr. 
John  Hackett,  archdeacon  of  Bedford,  after- 
wards bishop  of  Lichfield.  4.  Dr.  John 
Barwick,  successively  dean  of  Durham  and 
St.  Paul's.  5.  Dr.  Peter  Gunning,  succes- 
sively master  of  Corpus  and  St.  John's, 
Cambridge,  afterwards  bishop  of  Chichester. 
6.  Dr.  John  Pearson,  successively  master  of 
Jesus  and  Trinity  College,  Cambridge,  after- 
wards bishop  of  Chester.  7.  Dr.  Pierce.  8. 
Dr.  Anthony  Sparrow,  archdeacon  of  Sud- 
bury, afterwards  bishop  of  Norwich.  9. 
Mr.  Hubert  Thomdike,  prebendary  of  West- 
minster. 

On  the  Presbyterian  side. 
Principals. 

1.  Dr.  Reynolds,  afterwards  bishop  of 
Norwich.  2.  Dr.  Tuckney,  Master  of  St. 
John's,  Cambridge.  3.  Dr.  Conant,  Regius 
Professor  of  Divinity,  Oxford.  4.  Dr. 
Spurstow.  5.  Dr.  Wallis,  Savilian  Professor 
of  Astronomy,  Oxford.  6.  Dr.  Manton.  7. 
Dr.  Calamy.  8.  Mr.  Baxter.  9.  Mr.  Jack- 
son. 10.  Mr.  Case.  11.  Mr.  Clark.  12. 
Mr.  Newcomen. 


PRAYER  BOOK 


Coadjutors. 


599 


1.  Dr.  Horton.  2.  Dr.  Jacomb.  3.  Mr. 
Bates.  4.  Mr.  Rawlinson.  5.  Mr.  Cooper.. 
6.  Dr.  Lightfoot.  7.  Dr.  CoUings.  8.  Dr. 
Woodbridge.     9.  Mr.  Drake. 

They  met  at  the  Master's  lodgings  at  the 
Savoy,  in  the  Strand,  from  April  15,  1661, 
to  July  24  of  the  same  year.  Their  dis- 
cussions were  prolonged  to  but  little  pur- 
pose. Many  of  the  "exceptions"  taken 
were  frivolous,  though  urged  with  great 
bitterness,  and  the  Conference  had  littla 
result,  except  it  were  that  of  showing  the 
impossibility  of  combining  Presbyterian  doc- 
trines with  those  expressed  by  the  Prayer 
Book.  A  committee  of  the  Upper  House 
of  Convocation  of  Canterbury  was  appointed, 
consisting  of: — 

Matthew  Wren,  bishop  of  Ely. 

Robert  Skinner,  bishop  of  Oxford. 

John  Warner,  bishop  of  Rochester. 

Humphrey  Henchman,  bishop  of  Salis- 
bury. 

George  Morley,  bishop  of  Worcester. 

Robert  Sanderson,  bishop  of  Lincoln. 

William  Nicholson,  bishop  of  Gloucester. 

John  Cosin,  bishop  of  Durham. 

The  co-operation  of  the  York  Lower 
House  of  Convocation,  as  well  as  that  of 
Canterbury,  was  secured,  and  the  work 
began.  The  Committee  met  at  Ely  House 
in  Holborn,  with  Sancroft  (afterwards  arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury)  as  their  secretary. 
All  of  them  were  men  of  known  learning 
and  piety.  Cosin  and  Wren  were  great  litur- 
gical scholars.  Wren  having  specially  studied 
the  liturgies  of  the  Eastern  Church.  Cosin 
had  prepared  a  folio  Prayer  Book  of  1619 
with  notes  and  emendations.  Sanderson 
had  made  careful  notes.  Wren  had  also 
prepared  during  his  imprisonment  in  the 
Tower  a  revision  of  the  Book  of  1639, 
"  observing  that  never  could  there  have  been 
an  opportunity  so  offenceless  on  the  Church's 
part  for  amending  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer  as  now,  when  it  hath  been  so  long 
disused  that  not  one  of  five  hundred  is  so 
perfect  in  it  as  to  observe  alterations."  His 
"  Rules  of  reforming "  were  1.  to  use  only 
words  such  as  be  commonly  understood, 
2.  to  remove  repetitions — such  as  "van- 
quish and  overcome," — 3.  to  set  right  what- 
ever is  not  very  perfect  and  right  be  it 
never  so  small,  4.  to  correct  every  error  of 
language, — as  the  use  of  which  for  who.  He 
noted  to  the  ornaments  rubric  "  Who  knows 
how  the  chancels  were  in  those  times  past 
so  many  having  been  demolished  and  many 
disused?"  "But  what  is  now  fit  to  be 
ordered  herein,  and  to  preserve  those  that 
are  still  in  use,  it  should  be  put  down  in 
express  wprds,  without  these  uncertainties 


600 


PEAYER  BOOK 


•which  breed  nothing  but  debate  and  scorn." 
His  note  on  the  prayer  for  the  Church  mili- 
tant is  remarkable,  strongly  pressing  for  the 
restoration  of  that  end  of  the  prayer  (after 
"other  adversity")  which  has  been  men- 
tioned above — "  of  all  rights  it  should  be 
added  again." 

The  chief  additions  made  to  the  book  at 
this  date  are  the  prayer  of  St.  Chrysostom 
at  morning  and  evening  prayer,  the  collects 
for  Ember  days,   for   Parliament  (it  may 
be  here  observed  that  "  most  religious  and 
gracious  "  are  alike  formal  epithets,  the  first 
referring  to  the  title  "defender  of  the  faith  " 
and  to  the  Consecration  of  the  sovereign), 
"  For    all  sorts    and   conditions   of  men " 
(where  "  profess  and  call  themselves  "  shows 
a    trace    of   Puritan    influence),    and    the 
General  Thanksgiving.     Some  of  the  collects 
were  altered,  and  that  for  the  Sixth  Sunday 
after  Epiphany  added.     The  Epistles  and 
Gospels  were  taken  from  the  new  translation 
of  the  Bible,  the  canticles,  psalms,  offertory 
sentences,  and  comfortable  words  remaining 
unaltered.     The  office  for  Baptism  of  Those 
of  Eiper  Years  was  added,  as  "  having  become 
necessary  by  the  growth  of  Anabaptism,  and 
may  always  serve   for  baptizing  natives  in 
our  plantations  and  others  converted  to  the 
faith."    It  is  interesting  to  note  this  slight 
rekindliug  of  the  missionary  spirit.     The 
forms  of  prayer  to  be  used  at  sea  were  also 
added  at  this  time,  and  are  supposed  to  have 
been  compiled  by  Bishop  Sanderson.     The 
use  of  the  Prayer  Book  survived   in  the 
navy  after  it  had  been  abolished  on  land, 
and  though  the  Parliament  had  endeavoured 
to  put  "  a  supply  of  prayer "  in  its  place. 
The  order  for  the  Burial  of  the  Dead,  besides 
the  necessary  change  of  phrase — committing 
"  the  body  to  the  deep,"  has  "  looking  for 
the  resurrection,"  instead  of  "in  sure  and 
certain  hope."    The  declaration  on  kneeling 
with  the  change  of  "  Corporal  Presence,"  for 
"real  and  essential"  was  replaced.     These 
were  the  chief  additions  and  alterations  made 
in  the  book,  and  the  principle  which  guided 
those  who  laboured  in  the  work  is  best  seen 
by  studying  the  preface  printed  at  the  begin- 
ning of  every  copy  of  the  Prayer  Book.    The 
revision  was  completed  by  December   20, 
1661,  and  the  MS.  of  the  revised  volume  with 
the  great  seal  attached  was  itself  attached  to 
the  fourth  Act  of  Uniformity,  14  Car.  2,  c.  4. 
Great  care  was  taken  in  the  printing,and  any 
unauthorised   copy   strictly  forbidden.     It 
was  ordered  to   come  into  use  in   every 
parish  church,  chapelry,  cathedral  church, 
college  or  hall,  on  the  Feast  of  St.  Bartholo- 
mew (August  24),  1662.     The  resistance  to 
the  use  of  the  Prayer  Book  of  some  of  the 
ministers,  who  had    intruded    themselves 
into  cures  of  souls,  caused  a  large  number, 
though  far  less  than  is  commonly  said,  to 


PRAYEE  BOOK 

be  ejected  from  the  places  they  had  taken 
for  themselves.  Even  if  they  were  the  2000 
commonly  alleged  by  Dissenters,  they  were  a 
very  small  proportion  of  the  intruders  only 
seventeen  years  before.  Probably  the  Church 
suffered  yet  more  from  those  who  remained 
and  conformed,  than  from  those  who  were 
ejected.  The  traditional  knowledge  and 
strong  bond  of  custom  to  which  the  com- 
pilers of  the  first  hook  and  their  successors 
had  largely  trusted,  was,  by  many  years  of 
maimed  obedience  and  fifteen  of  neglect, 
almost  effaced  and  undone,  and  an  ignorant 
irreverence  had  taken  its  place. 

There  have  been  no  alterations  in  the 
Prayer  Book  since  1662,  excepting  two 
revisions  of  the  Calendar,  one  in  1751, 
making  the  year  begin  on  January  1,  and 
correcting  the  table  to  find  Easter,  and 
dropping  eleven  days  in  1752 ;  and  another 
in  1871,  when  the  present  Lectionary  was 
introduced. 

The  Shortened  Services  Act  (35  &  36 
Vict.  c.  35)  does  not  alter  in  any  respect 
the  Prayer  Book  itself,  though  it  permits 
under  special  conditions  the  omission  of 
parts  of  mattins  and  evensong. 

The  special  services  for  November  5,  for 
January  30,  for  May  29,  were  all  appoint- 
ed by  Koyal  orders,  which  were  revoked  in 
1859 ;  and  the  Acts  for  the  observance  of 
those  days  were  repealed  by  22  Vict.  c.  2. 
The  service  for  the  Accession  was  enjoined 
by  a  canon  of  1640.  It  was  disused  in  Charles 
XL's  reign,  but  revived  by  James  II.,  and  after 
disuse  in  William  III.'s  reign,  and  some  re- 
vision, was  used  again  from  Queen  Anne's 
reign  until  now.  In  some  old  copies  of  the 
Prayer  Book  are  to  be  found  a  Form  of  prayer 
in  commemoration  of  the  fire  of  London, 
September  2,  1666,  which  was  revised  in 
1676  and  used  in  St.  Paul's  till  1859. 

The  office  used  at  "  the  Healing  "  (touch- 
ing for  the  king's  evil)  is  also  in  some 
copies  of  the  Prayer  Book,  especially  in 
those  of  Queen  Anne's  reign ;  but  none  of 
these  services,  nor  the  Thirty-nine  Articles, 
nor  the  Table  of  Degrees,  nor  either  of  the 
"  Metrical  Versions "  of  the  Psalms,  are 
integral  parts  of  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer.  The  Ordinal  (see  Ordinal)  was 
finally  incorporated  with  the  book  by  the 
last  Act  of  Uniformity.  Compiled,  like  the 
rest  of  the  hook,  from  many  ancient  sources, 
it  underwent  historically  the  same  vicissi- 
tudes, and  was  the  subject  of  vehement 
attack,  as  holding  the  very  key  of  the 
position.    [L.  P.] 

PRAYER  BOOK  OF  THE  CHURCH 
OF  SCOTLAND.  This  was  first  proposed 
by  James  I.,  who  endeavoured  abruptly  to 
introduce  the  English  Office  Book,  with  but 
little  success.  Spottiswode,  archbishop  of 
St.  Andrew's,  prepared  a  draft  of  a  liturgy 


PRAYEK  BOOK 

which  he  sent  to  King  James  and  which 
was  revised  by  Young,  dean  of  Windsor. 

In  1629  the  project  was  again  considered, 
and  in  1633  the  work  was  begun.  The 
persons  chiefly  concerned  in  it  were  Max- 
well, bishop  of  Ross,  and  Wedderburn, 
bishop  of  Dunblane ;  and  in  England,  Wren, 
then  bishop  of  Norwich,  and  Archbishop 
Laud.  The  introduction  of  the  book  in 
1637  was  unwisely  managed  by  those  con- 
cerned in  it,  and  Laud  says  they  "went 
not  the  right  way  by  a  general  assembly 
and  other  legal  courses  of  that  kingdom." 
Probably,  however  introduced,  it  would  have 
produced  a  storm,  for,  being  based  more 
upon  the  first  Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI. 
(see  above)  than  upon  that  of  Elizabeth,  it 
was  highly  uncongenial  to  the  Presbyterians. 
Its  fate,  like  that  of  the  Church,  was  even 
more  adverse  than  in  England;  but  when 
in  1689  the  Scottish  Convention  expelled 
the  bishops  and  resolved  to  abolish  Epi- 
scopacy, the  persecuted  Church  revised  her 
Service  Book  and  reintroduced  it,  as  it  now 
exists.  The  principal  variations  from  the 
English  book  are  : — In  the  ofB.ce  of  Holy 
Communion  which  retains  the  Invocation 
in  the  Consecration  prayer,  a  more  express 
commemoration  of  the  saints  and  faithful 
departed,  and  generally  follows  the  lines 
of  the  "  first  Prayer  Book ;  "  in  Holy  Bap- 
tism a  special  blessing  of  the  water  ;  in 
Confirmation  the  signing  of  the  cross  by 
the  bishop  on  the  forehead  of  each  person 
confirmed.  The  Preface  to  the  Ordinal 
contains  a  strong  assertion  of  the  continuity 
of  the  Scotch  orders,  and  of  the  necessity 
of  Episcopal  ordination.  But  the  latest 
Scotch  canons  allow  the  use  also  of  the 
English  Consecration  prayer  in  the  Commu- 
aion.     [L.  P.] 

PRAYER  BOOK  OP  THE  CHURCH 
IN  AMERICA.  The  Church  in  America, 
as  she  received  her  first  bishop  from  Scot- 
land, so  also  based  her  communion  office  upon 
that  of  the  Scotch  Prayer  Book.  In  other 
respects  her  offices  follow  with  few  variations 
the  English  Book.  Of  these  the  most  im- 
jwrtant  are  the  omission  of  the  Athanasian 
Creed,  and  of  the  Absolution  in  the  Visitation 
of  the  Sick,  the  addition  of  offices  for  Visita- 
tion of  prisoners,  of  Harvest  Thanksgiving,  of 
Consecration  of  a  Church  or  Chapel,  of  Insti- 
tution of  Ministers,  and  a  Hymnal,  all 
incoqoorat«d  with  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer.  The  three  Prefaces  of  the  English 
Book  are  replaced  by  one  deprecating  any 
intention  to  depart  from  the  Church  in 
England  "  in  any  essential  point  of  doctrine, 
■discipline,  or  worship"  (See  American 
Prayer  Book).     [L.  P.] 

PRAYER  BOOK  IN  IRELAND.  The 
first  Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI.  (see  above) 
was    used   in    Christ    Church   Cathedral, 


PREACHING 


GOl 


Dublin,  Easter  Day  (April  6),  1549,  and 
was  printed  for  Ireland  in  1551,  but  little 
effort  was  made  to  promote  its  use. 

In  1559,an  Act  of  Queen  Elizabeth  ordered 
the  use  of  the  second  Book  of  Edward  VI., 
with  a  permission  to  use  it  in  Latin,  because 
in  most  places  of  the  realm  no  English  min- 
ister could  be  found,  and  there  were  great 
difficulties  in  printing  it  in  Irish  and  "  few  in 
the  whole  realm  can  read  Irish  letters." 
Thus  the  services  remained  in  their  old  con- 
dition of  being  understood  (when  used  in 
Latin)  by  the  minister,  and  not  as  a  rule, 
either  in  Latin  or  in  English,  by  the  common 
people.  Efforts  were  made  by  some  of  the 
Irish  bishops  to  improve  matters  in  King 
Charles's  reign,  but  in  1649  the  ordinance 
of  the  Parliament  abolished  the  bishops,  and 
forbade  the  use  of  the  Prayer  Book.  In 
1665  the  Irish  Convocation,  having  "  dili- 
gently considered  "  the  revised  Prayer  Book, 
recommended  its  adoption,  and  it  was  ap- 
pended to  an  Act  of  Uniformity  in  1666. 
The  Irish  book  contained  as  additions  (1) 
a  Service  of  Thanksgiving  for  yearly  use  of 
October  23,  for  the  "  Discovery  of  the  Con- 
spiracy to  blow  up  Dublin  Castle  and  mur- 
der all  Protestants  in  1641 ;  "  (2)  a  "  Prayer 
for  the  Lord  Lieutenant;"  (3)  a  form  of 
"  Visitation  of  Prisoners ; "  (4)  a  form  of 
"  Consecration  or  dedication  of  Churches  and 
Chapels  ;  "  (5)  a  short  office  for  "  Expiation, 
and  Illustration  of  a  Church  desecrated  or 
prophan'd."  After  Jan.  1, 1871,  the  Church 
of  Ireland  ceased  to  bean  established  Church, 
and  it  was  arranged  that  it  should  be  gov- 
erned by  a  representative  body,  or  synod,  of 
elected  clergy  and  laity.  In  187  7  the  synod 
revised  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer,  mak- 
ing certain  alterations  and  additions,  for 
which  see  article  on  Cliurch  of  Ireland. 

PRAYER  BOOK,  LATIN  (See  Latin 
Prayer  Book  ;   Oblations). 

PREACHING  (See  Extempore  Preach- 
ing). Proclaiming  or  publicly  setting  forth 
the  truths  of  religion.  Hence  the  reading 
of  Scriptm-e  to  the  congregation  is  one 
branch  of  preaching,  and  is  so  denominated 
in  Acts  XV.  21,  "Moses  of  old  time  hath 
in  every  city  them  that  preach  him,  be- 
ing read  in  the  synagogues  every  sabbath 
day."  The  term  is,  however,  now  gene- 
rally restricted  to  the  delivering  of  sermons, 
lectures,  &c.  When  the  preaching  of  our 
Blessed  Lord,  or  His  apostles,  is  referred  to 
by  ancient  writers,  the  word  used  is  day- 
ye\iC€(r6ai  (St.  Luke  iv.  18 :  ix.  2 ;  1  Cor. 
i.  17 ;  Gal.  i.  11,  &c.) ;  but  afterwards, 
when  the  Gospels  were  written  down,  and 
ordered  to  be  read  in  the  ohm'ches,  the  ex- 
position or  exhortation  was  called  Kxjpvyjxa, 
or  8tSao-/caXia,  and  in  Latin  doctrina 
and  instmctio ;  and  sermons  were  ofiiKiai, 
Xdyot,  tractatus  or  sermones  (See  Sermons). 


602 


PBEACHING 


The  ordinance  of  preaching  has  always 
been  held  in  the  highest  honour.  Justin 
Martyr  speaks  of  the  president  at  the 
service  (Trpofo-ro)?,  which  probably  means 
the  bishop)  admonishing  through  words 
(Sia  Xdyou),  and  exhorting  all  to  the 
imitation  of  the  noble  deeds,  of  which  they 
had  heard  in  the  lessons  from  Holy  Writ 
(^Apol.  i.  c.  67).  Grregory  Nazianzen  refers 
to  it  as  the  principal  thing  that  pertains 
to  the  ministers  of  the  Gospel — Trpwrov 
tZv  vTrqperav  (^Orat.  i.).  Only  the  bishops, 
apparently,  preached  in  the  earliest  times  ; 
and  this  rule  was  long  observed  in  the 
African  Churches.  To  this  duty  of  the 
episcopal  office  St.  Cyril  of  Alexandria 
refers  (Epist.  ad  Monach.  in  Cone.  Ephes.), 
as  well  as  St.  Ambrose,  and  other  early 
writers  (See  Bingham,  xiv.  4).  At  the 
Council  of  Laodicea,  a.d.  366,  the  same  rule 
is  referred  to  (c.  19),  "  Trepi  tov  Selv  I8ia 
irpStTov  fura  Tas  ofuKlas  rav  cTTtcKOTroij/," 
&c. ;  but  this  may  be  regarded  as  relating 
only  to  the  solemn  service  at  the  admission 
of  Catechumens.  Still,  that  the  idea  long 
remained  is  evident  from  a  canon  in  the 
Council  in  TruUo,  a.d.  691,  when  the 
bishop's  duty  of  preacliing  constantly,  and 
especially  on  the  Lord's  day,  is  mentioned 
(Labbe's  Condi,  iv.  1151).  St.  Augustine 
speaks  of  preaching  as  the  proper  office  of  a 
bishop  (De  Offic.  i.  c.  1) ;  but,  at  the  same 
time,  he  was  the  first  presbyter  in  Africa 
who  preached  in  the  presence  of  the  bishop 
(Possid.  Vit.  August.  5).  St.  Chrysostom, 
commenting  on  St.  Paul's  words — "A  bishop 
must  be  apt  to  teach,"  refers  to  this  as  an 
especial  duty  on  his  part  (Som.  x.  in  1 
Tim.  iii.).  Though  it  was  thus  considered 
as  a  special  function  of  the  bishop  to  preach, 
addresses  might  be  given  by  presbyters. 
Thus,  in  the  so-called  Apostolic  Constitutions, 
a  canon  runs  :  "  Let  the  presbyters,  but  not 
all,  exhort  the  people;  and  last  of  all  the 
bishop,  who  is  like  unto  the  governor  of  the 
ship  "  (ii.  57).  It  would  appear  from  the 
early  writers  that  in  different  churches 
there  were  different  rules  regarding  the 
preaching  of  presbyters.  The  subject  will 
be  found  fully  considered  in  Professor 
Cheetham's  article  on  preaching  in  the 
Dictionary  of  Christian  Antiquities. 

Deacons  were  not  at  first  allowed  to 
preach  (Bingham,  ii.  20).  When  the  words 
KTfpvaa-eiv,  KrjpirypM,  or  prseco  are  applied  to 
them,  they  imply  simply  the  giving  out  of 
notices,  or  calling  the  people  to  prayer. 
But  even  with  regard  to  this,  and  to  lay- 
men's preaching,  there  appears  sometimes 
to  have  been  a  relaxation  of  the  rule.  Origen, 
when  a  layman,  was  requested  by  Alexander, 
bishop  of  Jemsalem,  to  preach  before  him 
(Euseb.  Hist.  lib.  vi.  c.  19);  and  other 
instances  may  be  given.     But  the  rule  was 


PREACHING 

against  lay-preaching,  even  by  monks. 
Women  were  apparently  inclined  some-- 
times  to  assert  "  their  rights "  with  regard 
to  preaching.  As  to  the  Apostolic  rule  in 
this  case,  we  have  only  to  refer  to  1  Cor. 
xiv.  34;  1  Tim.  ii.  11;  but  amongst 
heretical  sects,  women  were  wont  to  hold 
forth,  as  appears  from  TertuUian :  "  Ips<B 
mulieres  hajreticse  quam  procaces,  quse  au- 
deant  dicere  "  (Z)e  Priescript.  c.  41) ;  and 
prohibitions  were  issued  against  their  preach- 
ing (Co7ist.  Apost.  iii.  9 ;  4  Cone.  CartJi.  c. 
99,  &c.). 

ll.  In  England  the  duty  of  preaching, 
was  early  enjoined.  Probably  after  St. 
Augustine's  time  for  some  years  the  bishops' 
only  preached.  But  at  the  Council  of 
Clovesho,  A.D.  747,  every  priest  was  orderedi 
carefully  and  diligently  to  perform  this  duty 
(c.  9).  Restrictions  with  regard  to  preaching 
similar  to  those  mentioned  above  are  pointed 
out  by  the  canonist  Ly  ndwood :  "  Nota  quod 
non  omnis  qui  vult  prsedicare,  debet  ad  hoc 
admitti.  Nam  mere  laicus  nee  publice  nee 
private  potest  prsedicare,  nee  etiam  mulier 
.  .  .  .  loquendo  de  clericis  babes  scire,  quod 
papa  ubique  potest  prajdicare ;  episcopi  vero 
ubique  possunt  prjedicare  nisi  per  dioecesanos 
prohibeantur  expresse,  juxta  iUud  Marc. 
Euntes  in  mundum  universum  predicate, 
quod  dictum  fuit  apostolis,  in  quorum  loco 
succedunt  episcopi.  Auctoritatem  tamen 
praedicandi  aliis  dare  non  possunt,  nisi  in  pro- 
priis  dioecesibus.  Inferiores  vero  praslati,  sive 
curati,  subditis  sibi  commissis  praidicare 
possunt,  etiam  si  fuerint  diaconi  tantum," 
&c.  (Lyndwood,  lib.  3,  tit.  4 :  lib.  5,  tit.  5  ; 
Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  ii.  cxxvii.).  After  the 
Reformation,  as  certain  persons  were  wont 
to  assert  their  right  of  preaching  without 
any  authority,  rules  and  restrictions  were 
given  for  the  ministers  in  the  Church  of 
England;  such  as  is  contained  in  Article 
xxiii.,  which  need  not  be  quoted,  as  it  is  to 
be  found  in  the  Prayer  Book.     [H.] 

By  canon  36,  "No  person  shall  be  re- 
ceived into  the  ministry,  nor  admitted  to  any 
ecclesiastical  living,  nor  suffered  to  preach, 
to  catechise,  or  to  be  a  lecturer  or  reader 
of  divinity  in  either  university,  or  in  any 
cathedral,  or  coUegiate  church,  city,  or 
market  town,  parish  church,  chapel,  or  any 
other  place  within  this  realm,  except  he 
be  licensed  either  by  the  archbishop  or  by 
the  bishop  of  the  diocese  where  he  is  to  be 
placed,  under  their  hands  and  seals,  or  by 
one  of  the  two  universities  under  their 
seal  likewise ;  and  except  he  shall  first 
subscribe  to  the  three  articles  concerning 
the  king's  supremacy,  the  Book  of  Com- 
mon Prayer,  and  the  Thirty-nine  Articles 
(see  Orders) :  and  if  any  bishop  shall 
license  any  person  without  such  subscrip- 
tion, he  shall  be   suspended  -from  giving 


PEEAOHING 

licences  to  preach  for  the  space  of  twelve 
months." 

And  by  the  31  Elizabeth,  c.  6,  "If  any 
person  shall  receive  or  take  any  money, 
fee,  reward,  or  any  other  profit,  dhectly 
or  indirectly,  or  any  promise  thereof,  either 
to  himself  or  to  any  of  his  friends  (all  or- 
dinary and  lawfully  fees  only  excepted),  to 
procm-e  any  licence  to  preach,  he  shall 
forfeit  £40." 

After  the  preacher  shall  be  licensed, 
then  it  is  ordained  as  follows : 

Canon  45.  "Every  beneficed  man,  al- 
lowed to  be  a  preacher,  and  residing  on 
his  benefice,  having  no  lawful  impediment, 
shall,  in  his  own  cure,  or  in  some  other 
church  or  chapel  (where  he  may  conveni- 
ently) near  adjoining,  where  no  preacher 
is,  preach  one  sermon  every  Sunday  of  the 
year ;  wherein  he  shall  soberly  and  sin- 
cerely divide  the  word  of  truth,  to  the 
glory  of  God,  and  to  the  best  edification 
of  the  people." 

Canon  47.  "  Every  beneficed  man,  li- 
censed by  the  laws  of  this  realm  (upon 
urgent  occasions  of  other  service)  not  to 
reside  upon  his  benefice,  shall  cause  his 
cure  to  be  supplied  by  a  curate  that  is  a 
sufiicient  and  licensed  preacher,  if  the 
worth  of  the  benefice  will  bear  it.  But 
whosoever  hath  two  benefices  shall  main- 
tain a  preacher  licensed,  in  the  benefice 
where  he  doth  not  reside,  except  he  preach 
himself  at  both  of  them  usually." 

Canon  50.  "Neither  the  minister,  church- 
wardens, nor  any  other  ofiBcers  of  the 
Church,  shall  suffer  any  man  to  preach 
within  their  churches  or  chapels,  but  such 
as  by  showing  their  licence  to  preach  shall 
appear  unto  them  to  be  sufficiently  author- 
ized thereunto,  as  is  aforesaid." 

Canon  51.  "  The  deans,  presidents  and 
residentiaries  of  any  cathedral  or  collegi- 
ate church  shall  suffer  no  stranger  to 
preach  unto  the  people  in  their  churches, 
except  they  be  allowed  by  the  archbishop 
of  the  province,  or  by  the  bishop  of  the 
same  diocese,  or  by  either  of  the  universities ; 
and  if  any  in  his  sermon  shall  publish  any 
doctrine  either  strange  or  disagreeing  from 
the  word  of  God,  or  from  any  of  the  Thirty- 
nine  Articles,  or  from  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer,  the  dean  or  residents  shall  by  their 
letters,  subscribed  with  some  of  their  hands 
that  heard  him,  so  soon  as  may  be,  give 
notice  of  the  same  to  the  bishop  of  the 
diocese,  that  he  may  determine  the  matter, 
and  take  such  order  therein  as  he  ^hall 
think  convenient." 

Canon  52.  "  That  the  bishop  may  under- 
stand (if  occasion  so  require)  what  sermons 
are  made  in  every  church  of  his  diocese,  and 
who  presume  to  preach  without  licence,  the 
churchwardens  and  sidesmen  shall  see  that 


PEEBEND 


60S 


the  names  of  all  preachers  which  come  to 
their  church  from  any  other  place  be  noted 
in  a  book,  which  they  shall  have  ready  for 
that  purpose,  wherein  every  preacher  shall 
inscribe  his  name,  the  day  when  he 
preached,  and  the  name  of  the  bishon  of 
whom  he  had  licence  to  preach." 

Canon  53.  "  If  any  preacher  shall  in  the. 
pulpit  particularly,  or  namely  of  purpose, 
impugn  or  confute  any  doctrine  delivered 
by  any  other  preacher  in  the  same  church,, 
or  in  any  church  near  adjoining,  before  he 
hath  acquainted  the  bishop  of  the  diocese 
therewith,  and  received  order  from  him 
what  to  do  in  that  case,  because  upon  such 
public  dissenting  and  contradicting  there 
may  grow  much  offence  and  disquietness 
unto  the  people,  the  churchwardens  or  party 
aggrieved  shall  forthwith  signify  the  same 
to  the  said  bishop,  and  not  suffer  the  said 
preacher  any  more  to  occupy  that  place 
which  he  hath  once  abused,  except  he  faith- 
fully promise  to  forbear  all  such  matter  ot 
contention  in  the  church,  until  the  bishop 
hath  taken  further  order  therein;  who- 
shall  with  all  convenient  speed  so  proceed 
therein,  that  public  satisfaction  may  be 
made  in  the  congregation  where  the  offence 
was  given.  Provided,  that  if  either  of  the 
parties  offending  do  appeal,  he  shall  not  be 
suffered  to  preach  pendente  lite." 

Canon  55.  "  Before  all  sermons,  lectures, 
and  homilies,  the  preachers  and  ministers- 
shall  move  the  people  to  join  with  them  in 
prayer,  in  this  form,  or  to  this  effect,  as 
briefly  as  conveniently  they  may  :  Ye  shall 
pray  for  Christ's  Holy  Catholic  Church,"  &c. 
(See  Bidding  Prayer). 

The  Preface  to  the  Ordinal,  which  is 
ratified  by  Act  of  Parliament  though  thc- 
Canons  are  not,  is  still  more  decisive ;  "  No 
man  shall  be  accounted  a  bishop,  priest,  or 
deacon  in  the  Church  of  England,  or  suffered 
to  execute  any  of  the  said  functions-"  (of 
which  preaching  is  expressly  one)  "  except 
he  be  .  .  .  admitted  thereunto  according  to 
the  form  hereafter  following,  or  hath  had 
formerly  episcopal  ordination."  In  the  face 
of  all  this,  and  Lynd  wood's  early  statement  of 
the  law,  it  is  diificult  to  understand  how 
a  few  bishops  and  other  people  can  have 
imagined  that  a  licence  from  a  bishop  to  a 
layman  to  preach  is  worth  anything,  being 
unnecessary  for  preaching  anywhere  but 
in  church,  and  invalid  and  unlawful  for 
preaching  in  church.     [G.] 

PREBEND  (Lat.  Prsebenda).  The  stipend 
which  is  received  by  a  prebendary,  from 
the  revenues  of  the  cathedral  or  collegiate 
church  with  which  he  is  connected.  It 
denoted  originally  any  stipend  or  reward, 
given  out  of  the  ecclesiastical  revenues,  to  a 
person  who  had  by  his  labours  procured 
benefit  to  the  Church;    and  the  gratuity 


•604 


PEEBENDABY 


whicli  was  given  either  to  a  proctor  or  ad- 
vocate, or  any  otlier  person  of  tlie  like  kind. 
"When  the  cathedral  churches  became  well 
•endowed,  they  left  off  receiving  the  income 
of  thek  lands  into  one  common  bank,  and 
■dividing  it  among  the  members,  but  par- 
celled out  the  lands  into  several  shares, 
appropriating  them  for  the  maintenance  of 
each  single  clergyman  who  resided  about  the 
cathedral,  calling  it  Prsebenda,  or  Corpus 
Trxbendie,  the  Corps  of  the  Prebend.  Hence 
arose  the  difference  between  a  prebends  and 
a  canonry.  A  canonry  was  a  right  which  a 
person  had  in  a  church,  to  be  deemed  a 
member  thereof,  to  have  assigned  to  him  a 
stall  therein,  and  to  give  a  vote  in  the  chap- 
ter ;  but  a  prebend  was  a  piece  of  property 
attached  to  a  particular  stall.  The  num- 
ber of  prebends  in  the  several  cathedral 
churches  was  increased  by  the  benefactions 
of  respective  founders ;  oftentimes  out  of 
the  revenues  of  the  rural  clergy,  and  often- 
times by  exonerating  the  lands  of  prebends 
from  paying  tithes  to  the  ministers  of  the 
parishes  where  they  lay  (See  Canons). 
There  is  now  at  any  rate  no  real  differ- 
ence. The  residentiaries  are  canons  by  Act 
of  Parliament,  and  the  non-residentiaries 
have  no  estates  individually  or  collectively. 
But  in  a  few  old  cathedrals  the  non-re- 
sidentiaries are  still  called  prebendaries; 
though  by  s.  1  of  the  3  &  4  Vic.  113, 
all  the  members  of  chapter,  except  the 
dean,  are  to  be  styled  canons.  But  the  Act 
was  so  altered  in  its  progress  that  there  are 
various  inconsistencies  in  it. 

PBEBENDARY.  A  clergyman  attached 
to  a  cathedral  or  coUegiate  church,  who 
formerly  enjoyed  a  prebend  in  consideration 
of  his  officiating  at  stated  times  in  the 
church.  By  the  Act  of  1840  most  of  the 
prebendal  stalls  have  been  deprived  of  their 
endowments,  but  the  holders  of  them  are 
still  called  prebendaries  (See  Dean  and 
Cluipter). 

In  Scotland,  there  were  estabhshed  by  the 
respective  founders  in  the  colleges  of  St. 
Salvador,  at  St.  Andrew's,  and  King's 
College,  Aberdeen,  certain  "  Prebendaries, 
or  perpetual  chaplains,  to  sing  and  serve  in 
the  choir"  of  the  chapel.  These  were,  in 
fact,  the  same  as  chaplains  in  the  choral 
<x)lleges  of  England. 

PRECEISTTOE.  The  leader  of  a  choir. 
'There  is  no  mention  of  this  office  before  the 
4th  century ;  then  it  appears  that  in  many 
churches  one  singer,  the  precentor  or  pro- 
nuntiator,  recited  the  first  half  of  a  verse 
and  the  people  took  up  the  rest  (Diet. 
Christ.  Antiq.  p.  1691).  Afterwards  the 
office  was  considered  very  important,  and 
the  holder  invested  with  great  dignity.  The 
precentor  in  almost  all  cathedrals  of  old 
foundation  in  England,  and  very  generally 


PEEDESTINATION 

on  the  continent,  was  the  first  dignitary 
in  the  chapter  after  the  dean.  In  some 
few  instances  the  archdeacons  preceded 
him.  He  superintended  the  choral  service, 
and  the  choristers;  and  in  Paris  the -pre- 
centor of  Notre-Dame  had  the  supervision 
of  the  lesser  schools  in  the  city,  as  the 
chancellor  had  of  the  greater.  In  all  the 
new  foundations,  the  precentor  is  a  minor 
canon.  In  most  ancient  cathedrals  the  pre- 
centor had  for  his  badge  of  office  a  silver  staff 
or  haculus.  In  choral  colleges  the  precentor 
is  a  chaplain.  At  Llandaff  and  St.  David's, 
till  very  lately,  the  precentor  was  presby  teral 
head  of  the  chapter.  At  York  he  need  not 
be  a  residentiary ;  but  the  canonry  of  Drif- 
field was  annexed  to  the  office. 

PREOEPTORIES  were  manors  or  estates 
of  the  Knights  Templars,  on  which  they 
erected  churches  for  religious  service,  and 
convenient  houses  for  habitation,  and  placed 
some  of  their  fraternity  imder  the  govern- 
ment of  one  of  those  more  eminent  Templars, 
who  had  been  by  the  grand  master  created 
" preeceptores  templi,^  to  take  care  of  the 
lands  and  rents  in  that  place  and  neighbour- 
hood :  these  preceptories  were  only  cells  to  the 
Temple,  or  principal  houses  of  the  knights, 
in  London.  Preceptor  was  the  title  of  the 
head  of  some  old  hospitals. 

PRECES.  The  Latin  word  for  prayers  ; 
but  it  is  often  applied  in  a  technical  sense 
to  the  shorter  sentences,  as  versicles  and 
suffrages  which  are  said  in  the  way  of  verse 
and  response.  The  longer  prayers  were 
called  "  orationes,"  and  were  in  fact  equiva- 
lent to  our  collects.  The  distinction  is 
given  by  St.  Cyprian,  who  speaks  of  the 
"  preces  "  as  a  htany  (Ep.  62,  ad  Janiiar.). 
In  the  English  service  the  term  is  hmited  to 
those  versicles  (with  the  Gloria  Patri)  im- 
mediately preceding  the  Psalms,  beginning 
"  O  Lord,  open  thou  our  lips,"  and  those 
after  the  Creed.  These  anciently  formed  a 
regular  part  of  the  harmonized  services  for 
cathedral  choirs,  which  were  set  to  music  by 
an  earher  musician  (See  Responses,  Versi- 
cles, and  Service). 

PREDESTINATION  (See  Election : 
see  also  Calvinism  and  Arminianism).  Of 
predestination  and  election  our  17th  Article 
thus  speaks  :  "  Predestination  to  life  is  the 
everlasting  purpose  of  God,  whereby  (before 
the  foundations  of  the  world  were  laid)  he 
hath  constantly  decreed  by  his  counsel  se- 
cret to  us,  to  deliver  from  curse  and  dam- 
nation those  whom  he  hath  chosen  in  Christ 
out  of  mankind,  and  to  bring  them  by 
Christ  to  everlasting  salvation,  as  vessels 
made  to  honour.  Wherefore  they  which  be 
endued  with  so  excellent  a  benefit  of  God, 
be  called  according  to  God's  purpose,  by  his 
Spirit  working  in  due  season ;  they  through 
grace  obey  the  calling;  they  be  justified 


PREDESTINATION 

freely ;  they  lie  made  sons  of  Grod  by  adop- 
tion ;  they  he  made  Uke  the  image  of  his 
only-begottea  Son  Jesus  Christ ;  they  walk 
rehgiously  in  good  works;  and  at  length, 
by  God's  mercy,  they  attain  to  everlastino; 
felicity.  As  the  godly  consideration  of 
predestination  and  our  election  in  Christ  is 
full  of  sweet,  pleasant,  and  unspeakable 
comfort  to  godly  persons,  and  such  as  feel 
in  themselves  the  working  of  the  Spirit  of 
Christ,  mortifying  the  works  of  the  flesh 
and  their  earthly  members,  and  drawing 
up  their  mind  to  high  and  heavenly  i  things, 
as  well  because  it  doth  greatly  establish 
and  confirm  their  faith  of  eternal  salvation 
to  be  enjoyed  through  Christ,  as  because 
it  doth  fervently  kindle  their  love  towards 
Grod :  so,  for  curious  and  carnal  persons 
lacking  the  Spirit  of  Christ,  to  have  con- 
tinually before  their  eyes  the  sentence  of 
Grod's  predestination,  is  a  most  dangerous 
downfall,  whereby  the  devil  doth  thrust 
them  either  into  desperation,  or  into 
wretchedness  of  most  unclean  living,  no 
less  perilous  than  desperation.  Further- 
more, we  must  receive  God's  promises  in 
such  wise,  as  they  be  generally  set  forth 
to  us  in  Holy  Scripture  :  and,  in  our  doings, 
that  will  of  God  is  to  be  followed,  which  we 
have  expressly  declared  unto  ns  in  the 
Word  of  God." 

Such  is  the  barrier  which  the  Church 
places  between  this  solemn  subject  and 
irreverent  inquiries;  but  the  Scripture 
doctrine  of  predestination  may  be  further 
stated  without  any  forgetfulness  of  the 
spirit  here  inculcated.  We  are  told  indeed 
by  the  Church,  that  "  the  godly  considera- 
tion of  predestination  and  our  election  in 
Christ  is  full  of  sweet  and  imspeakahle 
comfort  to  godly,  persons"  (Art.  xvii.); 
and  it  is  certain  that  it  can  be  full  neither 
of  profit  nor  of  comfort,  unless  we  meditate 
upon  it.  And  if  it  be  among  the  things 
"  hard  to  be  understood"  (2  St.  Pet.  iii.  16), 
this  is  no  reason  why  we  should  not  try  to 
understand  it,  and,  by  understanding,  cease 
to  be  "unlearned  and  unstable,"  and  so 
take  care  that  it  shall  not  be  wrested  to  our 
destruction. 

In  the  first  chapter  to  the  Ephesians,  we 
find  that  there  are  certain  persons  whom 
God  hath  chosen  in  Christ,  before  the 
foundation  of  the  world;  having  predesti- 
nated them  unto  the  adoption  of  children  of 
Jesus  Christ  to  Himself,  not  on  account  of 
their  good  works,  but  according  to  the  good 
pleasure  of  His  wUl  (Eph.  i.  4,  5).  Again, 
in  another  Epistle,  we  are  told  that  God 
hath  "called  us  with  a  holy  calling,  not 
according  to  our  works,  but  according  to  His 
own  purpose  and  grace,  which  was  given  us 
in  Christ  Jesus  before  the  world  began" 
(2  Tim.  1.  9).    These  are  persons  whose 


PREDESTINATION 


603 


names  are  said  to  have  been  written  in 
heaven,  in  the  book  of  life,  called  the 
Lamb's  book  of  life  (Eev.  xx.  15  :  xxi.  27), 
because  the  first  among  God's  elect  is  He 
who,  being  God  as  well  as  man,  is  the  Lamb 
of  God,  slain  from  the  foundation  of  th& 
world  (Rev.  xiii.  8)  as  a  propitiation  for 
sins  (1  St.  John  ii.  2  ;  iv.  10).  Thus,  then, 
we  see  that  there  are  persons  who  in  the 
words  of  St.  Paul,  are  "  vessels  which  God 
hath  afore  prepared  unto'  Glory  "  (Rom.  ix. 
22-24). 

And  now  comes  the  question,  WJio  are 
those  who  are  thus  predestinated  to  the 
glories  of  the  new  heaven,  the  new  earth, 
the  new  Jerusalem,  which  is  to  come  down 
from  above?  (Eev.  xxi.  2).  Let  St.  Paul 
give  the  answer  :  "  Whom  He  did  predes- 
tinate, them  He  also  called  "  (Rom.  viii.  30)  : 
called  by  the  circumstances  under  which  He 
providentially  placed  them  either  by  the 
appearance,  in  the  first  ages,  of  an  apostle 
or  an  evangelist ;  or,  as  is  the  case  with  us, 
by  the  fact  of  our  being  bom  in  a  Christian 
land  :  "  and  whom  He  called,  them  He  also- 
justified  ; "  receiving  them,  for  Christ's  sake, 
as  His  own  children  in  holy  baptism,  He 
justified,  or,  for  the  same  Saviour's  sake, 
counted  as  holy,  those  who  as  yet  were  not 
actually  so :  "  and  whom  He  justified,  them 
He  also  glorified."  He  glorified  them  by 
regenerating  them,  and  making  them  tem- 
ples of  the  Holy  Ghost  (1  Cor.  vi.  11,  19)  ; 
than  which  what  greater  glory  can  pertain 
to  the  sons  of  men  ? 

The  foregoing  passage  furnishes  us  with 
a  description  of  Christians,  of  baptized 
persons;  and  consequently  to  Christians  we 
are  to  refer  those  other  passages  which  re- 
late to  God's  predestination :  them  God  hath 
predestinated  to  glory.  And  as  such,  as- 
God's  elect  people,  predestinated  not  merely 
to  means  of  grace,  for  this  were  clearly  in- 
adequate, but  to  glory  in  the  kingdom  of 
glory,  the  inspired  writers  were  wont  to 
address  the  multitude  of  the  bajjtized. 
Thus  the  apostle  addresses  the  Church  of 
the  Thessalonians,  good  and  had  com- 
mingled, as  "  knowing  "  their  "  election  of 
God"  (1  Thess.  i.  4).  Thus  St.  Peter 
speaks  of  "  the  strangers  scattered  through- 
out Pontus,  Galatia,  Cappadocia,  Asia,  and 
Bithynia,"  as  "  elect  according  to  the  fore- 
knowledge of  God  the  Father"  (1  St. Pet.  i. 
1) ;  and  he  speaks  of  them  afterwards  as  "  a 
chosen  generation,  a  royal  priesthood,  a  holy 
nation,  a  peculiar  people;"  and  the  writer 
of  the  Epistle  to  the  Hebrews  addresses 
the  Hebrews,  meaning  those  who  had  made 
profession  of  the  Christian  faith,  as,  "  holy 
brethren,  partakers  of  the  heavenly  calling." 
Such,  then,  is  our  blessing,  our  privilege, 
our  high  hope  as  Christians.  In  the  temple 
of  the  first  Jerusalem  there  was  a  variety  o? 


€06 


PREDESTINATION 


cliambers  or  mansions,  employed  for  differ- 
ent purposes,  though  all  relating  directly 
or  indirectly  to  the  services  of  the  sanctuary. 
In  the  new  Jerusalem,  which  will  itself  be 
the  temple  of  the  universe,  there  will  in  like 
manner  be  "  many  mansions  "  or  chambers : 
but  if  so,  those  mansions  or  chambers  in  the 
earthly  Jerusalem  having  been  intended  for 
a  variety  of  different  oflSces,  we  may  con- 
clude that  offices  of  different  cliaracters  will 
exist  in  the  new  Jerusalem.  It  is  very 
possible  that  we  are  not  only  each  of  us 
predestined  to  heaven,  but  predestined  also 
each  to  our  own  particular  place  in  heaven, 
that  our  very  mansion  is  fixed.  We  know 
that  God  has  predestinated  particular  per- 
sons to  particular  offices  here  on  earth,  long 
before  their  birth:  as,  for  example,  in  the 
case  of  Jeremiah,  God  saith,  "  Before  I 
formed  thee  in  the  belly,  I  knew  thee ;  and 
before  thou  earnest  forth  of  the  womb,  I 
sanctified  thee,  and  ordained  thee  a  prophet 
unto  the  nations."  And  so  with  respect  also 
to  St.  Paul,  we  are  told  that  it "  pleased  God 
to  separate  him  from  his  mother's  womb, 
that  he  might  preach  Christ  among  the  hea- 
then "  (Gal.  i.  15,  16).  Nay,  we  find  that 
this  is  really  to  be  the  case  with  respect  to 
the  next  world,  in  some  cases  at  least ;  for 
example,  when  the  Son  of  man  shall  sit  on 
the  throne  of  His  glory,  the  apostles  shall  sit 
on  twelve  thrones,  jud'',ing  the  twelve  tribes 
of  Israel  (St.  Matt.  xix.  28) :  a  particular  office 
is  allotted  to  them;  to  a  particular  office 
they  are  predestinated.  When  the  mother 
of  Zebedee's  children  prayed  that  her 
•children  might  sit,  the  one  on  the  right  hand, 
and  the  other  on  the  left,  in  our  Lord's  king- 
dom of  gloiy,  our  Lord  said,  "  to  sit  on  my 
right  hand  and  on  my  left,  is  not  mine  to 
give  "  (St.  Matt.  xx.  23).  No.  These  places 
are  designed  for  certain  persons  who  are  pre- 
paring, or  shall  be  prepared,  to  fill  the  same. 
This  is  already  fixed  in  the  counsels  of  God. 
These  places,  therefore,  are  not  mine  to  give. 
They  are  already  given.  Tour  place  is  also 
designated :  prepare  for  it  by  doing  your 
duty.  We  know  that  some  of  the  saints 
are  predestinated  to  a  mysterious  office,  the 
nature  of  which  we  cannot  understand,  but 
they  wUl  judge  angels  (1  Cor.  vi.  2,  3). 
And  at  the  last  day  shall  the  King  say  unto 
them  that  are  on  his  right  hand,  "  Come, 
ye  blessed  of  my  Father,  inherit  the  kingdom 
prepared  for  you  from  the  foundation  of  the 
world  "  (St.  Matt.  xxv.  34). 

But  this  predestination  to  glory  is,  like 
our  election,  conditional.  We  shall  not 
only  be  saved,  but  we  shall  occupy  a  predes- 
tined post  of  glory,  if  we  escape  condem- 
nation at  the  day  of  judgment;  not  other- 
wise. The  omission  of  all  reference  to  the 
day  of  judgment  is  the  vice  of  the  Calvin- 
istic  system.     The  man,  condemned  at  the 


PEEFAOES 

day  of  judgment,  will  find  an  addition  to 
his  pangs,  by  knowing  the  glory  to  which 
he  had  been  predestined,  had  he  not  per- 
verted his  ways.  But  if  our  sins  are  then 
found  blotted  out  by  the  blood  of  the  Lamb, 
we  know  that  a  certain  place  in  heaven  is 
designed  for  us,  for  which  we  are  shaped 
and  prepared  by  the  circumstances  under 
which  we  are  placed  while  on  earth  (See 
Bishop  Pearson's  23  and  24  Lectiones  "  de 
Prxdestinatione  "  in  Archdeacon  Churton's 
edition  of  his  minor  Works ;  also  SeiTaon  26 
on  Human  Responsibility  in  J.  H.  New- 
man's Parochial  Sermons). 

PRE-EXISTENCB  OF  CHRIST,  OUB 
LORD  (See  Generation').  His  existence 
before  He  was  bom  of  the  Virgin  Marj', 
and  even  before  the  creation  of  the  world 
by  Him.  The  fact  is  stated  thus  by  Bishop 
Bull  in  his  "  Defence  of  the  Nicene  Creed  "  : 
All  the  catholic  doctors  of  the  first  three 
centuries  taught  that  Jesus  Christ,  He  who 
was  afterwards  so  called,  existed  before  He 
became  man,  or  before  He  was  bom,  accord- 
ing to  the  flesh,  of  the  Blessed  Virgin,  in 
another  nature,  far  more  excellent  than  the 
human  natm-e;  that  He  appeared  to  holy 
men,  giving  them  an  earnest,  as  it  were,  of 
His  incarnation ;  that  He  always  presided 
over,  and  provided  for,  the  Church,  which 
in  time  to  come  He  would  redeem  with  His 
own  blood;  and  of  consequence  that,  from 
the  beginning,  the  whole  order  or  thread  of 
the  Divine  dispensation,  as  Tertullian  speaks, 
ran  through  Him :  further  yet,  that  He  was 
with  the  Father  before  the  foundations  of 
the  world,  and  that  by  Him  all  things  were 
made. 

PREFACE,  THE.  That  part  in  the 
office  for  Holy  Communion  recited  by  the 
priest,  beginning  with  :  "  It  is  very  meet, 
right,  and  our  bounden  duty,"  &c.  In  the 
ancient  Liturgies,  the  preface  is  merely  the 
introduction  to  the  Eucharistica  in  the 
Holy  Communion  office  (the  cvxapLa-rla  of 
St.  Paid,  1  Cor.  xiv.  16),  which  was  a  long 
thanksgiving  to  God  for  His  mercies ;  from 
which  probably  the  whole  service  took  its 
name.  Justin  Martyr  speaks  of  this  as  the 
ev^apLaTla  fVt  iTo\v,  or  the  thanksgiving 
for  the  manifold  mercies  of  God,  the  Father, 
Son,  and  Holy  Ghost  (Ajpol.  1,  c.  86).  The 
thanksgiving,  which  ^itself  is  a  preface  to 
the  consecration,  formed  a  large  portion  of 
every  primitive  liturgy,  and  in  the  course 
of  it,  or  at  the  end,  the  whole  body  of  the 
people  sung  the  hymn  Tersanctus,  or  Holi/, 
Holy,  Holy,  &c. — Palmer,  Orig.  Liturg.  ii. 
120 ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  1693 ;  D.  Evan's 
P.  B.    [H.] 

PREFACES,  PROPER.  About  the  be- 
ginning of  the  5th  century  various  thanks- 
givings, or  prefaces,  as  they  then  began  to 
be  called,  were  written  and  used  in  tlie 


PKEFACES 

Western  Churohes.     The  Sacramentaries  of 
Leo,  Gelasius,  and  Gregory  contain  a  proper 
jireface  for  nearly  every  Sunday  and  Festival 
in  the  year,   as  does  also  the   Mozarabic 
Missal,  and  the  Gallioan  liturgies  (Muratori, 
Liturgia  Bonvina;  Mabillon,  de  Liturgia 
Oall. ;  Neale  and  Forbes'  Qallican  Liturgies, 
Miss.  5,  p.  12).     The  introduction  of  these 
jjrefaces  by  individual  bishops  in  different 
■churches  seems  to  have  been  frequent,  and 
was  reprobated,  the  African  Church  order- 
ing that  no  new  prayers  or  prefaces  (prajfa- 
tiones)  should  be  used  which  had  not  been 
approved  by  general  authority  (  Cone.  Milevit. 
■c.  12,  A.D.  416).     The  number  of  the  pro- 
per prefaces  was  reduced  about  the  end  of 
the  twelfth  century  to  ten,   and    at   the 
period  when  our  Liturgy  was  revised  proper 
prefaces    for    only   a    few  occasions    were 
admitted.      They   mark   out  in  the  great 
festivals  the  chief  acts  of  the  manifestation 
of  the  Gfod-head  in  humanity — the  Incarna- 
tion, the  Resurrection,  the  Ascension,  the 
■descent  of  the  Holy  Ghost ;  and  these  sum 
up  all  in  the  adoration  of  the  God-head. 
The  days  for  which  these  prefaces  are  pro- 
vided are,  Christmas,  Easter,  Ascension,  and 
seven  days  after  each  of  these  festivals ;  also 
Whitsunday,  and  six  days  after;  together 
with   Trinity   Sunday.     Beside   these   five 
proper  prefaces,  the  Sarum  Missal  had  one 
for  Epiphany  and  seven  days  after,  one  for 
Ash    Wednesday  and  ferial  days  in  Lent, 
one  for  festivals  of  apostles  or  evangelists, 
and  one  for  the  festivals  of  the  Blessed 
Virgin.     The  Trinity  preface  was  used  on 
all  the  Sundays  after  Trinity,  and  at  every 
wedding  celebration.     With  regard  to  our 
proper  prefaces,   that  for  the  Nativity  is 
derived  from  a  collect  in  the  Sacramentary 
of  Gelasius   for  the  day  before;   that  for 
Easter  occurs  in  the  same  Sacramentarj^,  is 
found  in    the    monuments    of   the    early 
English  Church,  and  so  in  all  the  English 
liturgies  anterior  to  the  Reformation ;  the 
prefece  for  Ascension  is  Gregorian,  and  has 
been  used  by  the  English  Church  for  above 
1200  years ;  that  for  Pentecost  is  entirely 
remodelled,  iDut  based  on  an  ancient  GaUican 
form ;  and  that   for  Trinity  is  taken  from 
the  Sacramentary  of  Gelasius  (^Sacramentar. 
■48  Oelasii ;  Murat.  Lit.  Bom.  i.  494 ;  Sacra- 
ment. Greg.  Menard,  p.  75 ;  Murat.  ii.  67, 
■85 :  Mabillon,  de  Lit.  Gall.  p.  269 ;  Miss. 
Sar.  fol.  Ixxiv.  Ixxv.).     In  1549  the  prefa- 
tory part  of  the  Anthem,  "  Therefore  with 
angels,   and  archangels,"  &c.,  was  divided 
from  the  Hymn  "  Holy,  Holy,  Holy,"  &c., 
itself,  and  the  direction  was  given  that  the 
"  Clerks   should   sing "  the  latter ;  in  this 
following  the  ancient  custom  which  gave 
the  hymn  itself  to  the  people.     The  rubric 
was  afterwards  changed.     One  rubric  says 
here  shall  follow  "  Therefore  with  angels," 


PREFACES 


607 


&c.,  and  another  "  After  each  of  which 
prefaces  shall  immediately  be  sung  or  said : 
Therefore  vt^ith  angels,"  &c.  That  it  was  i 
the  custom  for  the  people  or  choir  to  join  in  j 
at  the  words  "  Holy,  Holy,  Holy,"  is  beyond  j 
question;  and  the  musical  services  at  the 
time  of  the  Reformation  show  this ;  Tallis, 
Marbecke,  and  other  composers  of  that  time 
having  arranged,  not  the  whole  anthem,  but 
the  hymn  only  to  music.  Palmer  remarks 
that  "  the  repetition  by  the  people  of  the 
portion  of  the  Preface,  beginning  'Therefore 
with  angels,'  never  was  the  custom  of  the 
primitive  Church,  and  could  not  have  been 
intended  by  those  who  revised  our  liturgy, 
nor  is  it  warranted  by  the  nature  of  the 
Preface  itself.  It  has  perhaps,"  he  adds, 
"  arisen  from  the  custom  of  printing  the 
latter  part  of  the  Preface  in  connexion  with 
the  hymn  Tersanctus,  and  from  the  in- 
distinctness of  the  rubric,  which,  in  fact, 
gives  no  special  direction  for  the  people  to 
join  in  repeating  the  hymn  Tersanctus." 
—Palmer's  Orig.  Liturg.  ii.  122,  129  (See 
Tersanctus). 

"The  choral  communion  services,  and 
the  one  of  Durham,  all  agree  in  beginning 
the  hymn  at  the  words, "  Holy,  Holy,  Holy," 
&c.  The  rubric  merely  says,  "  After  each 
of  which  Prefaces  shall  immediately  be  sung 
or  said ; "  it  does  not  say  by  whom.  The 
direction  is  as  indeterminate  as  that  of  the 
Litany,  which,  like  the  passage  in  question, 
is  sung  distributively  between  minister  and 
people  in  sequence.  "■ — Jebb's  Clurral  Service, 
p.  505 ;  see  also  Wheatly,  vi.  sec.  xviii. ; 
Procter,  347  ;  Bp.  Barry,  144,  a.     [H.] 

PREFACES  TO  THE  BOOK  OF  COM- 
MON PRAYER.  These  are  three  in  num- 
ber (i.)  That  which  stands  first  and  is 
styled  "The  Preface"  is  chronologically  the 
latest,  having  been  composed  at  the  last 
review,  a.d.  1661,  by  Dr.  Sanderson,  bishop 
of  Lincoln.  Its  main  purport  is  to  exhibit 
the  principles  upon  which  the  Prayer  Book 
had  been  already  revised  from  time  to  time, 
and  to  explain  the  causes  and  effects  of  the 
final  revision  then  just  completed,  (ii.)  The 
second,  entitled  "  Concerning  the  Service  of 
the  Church,"  was  the  Preface  from  1549  to 
1661.  It  is  supposed  to  have  been  written 
by  Cranmer,  and  is  based  in  a  great  measure 
upon  the  Preface  to  the  Refonned  Breviary 
of  Cardinal  Quinonez  published  by  autho- 
rity of  Pope  Clement  VII.  in  1535.  It 
treats  mainly  of  the  great  importance  of  the 
daily  reading  of  the  Scriptures,  and  saying  or 
singing  the  Psalms  in  the  service  of  the 
Church,  and  of  the  ways  in  which  the 
original  intention  of  the  Church  in  this 
resisect  had  been  defeated,  (iii.)  A  third, 
entitled  "  Of  Ceremonies,"  &c.,  is  also  at- 
tributed to  Cranmer,  and  was  placed  at  the 
end  of  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549  and  followed 


608 


PREMONSTEATENSES 


by  certain  rubrics  and  remarlis.  These 
■were  di'opped  in  1552,  and  the  treatise  on 
ceremonies  was  the  first  after  the  Preface. 
Its  object  is  to  defend  tlie  principles  on 
which  the  Reformers  had  remodelled  the 
ceremonial  of  the  Clmroh.  Some  ceremonies 
were  good  and  to  be  retained ;  some  origi- 
nally good  had  become  abused  and  were  to 
be  modified;  others  intrinsically  bad  were 
to  be  abolished.     [H.] 

PRELATE  (prielatus,  from  priefero  ;  one 
placed  above  another).  An  ecclesiastic 
having  jurisdiction  over  other  ecclesiastics. 
The  title,  though  applicable  to  bishops,  is 
not  confined  to  their  order.  Before  the 
Reformation  abbots  were  styled  prelates. 
Archdeacons  are  prelates  in  this  sense  of  the 
word  (See  Episcopacy ;  Bishop). 

PRELECTOR.  A  Lecturer.  In  the 
cathedral  of  Hereford,  one  of  the  preben- 
daries is  elected  to  the  office  of  Prelector, 
to  hold  it  till  he  succeeds  to  a  residentiary 
canonry,  for  which  he  is  statutably  con- 
sidered to  have  a  claim  to  be  a  candidate. 
His  duty  is  to  preach  on  Tuesdays,  or  else 
on  any  holiday  which  may  occur  during  the 
week  for  a  considerable  portion  of  the  year. 

PREMONSTRATENSBS  (Lat).  In 
French,  Premontres.  A  religious  order, 
founded  by  Norbert,  born  about  a.d.  1080, 
and  descended  from  a  noble  family  in  the 
diocese  of  Cologne.  He  was  educated  suit- 
ably to  his  quality,  and  lived  for  some  time 
at  the  emperor  Henry  the  Fifth's  court. 
At  about  thirty  years  of  age  he  was  ordained 
deacon  and  priest ;  and,  soon  after,  entering 
upon  a  very  strict  and  mortified  way  of 
living,  he  resigned  his  church  preferments, 
and  distributed  a  large  patrimonial  estate 
to  the  poor.  Then  he  embraced  the  rule  of 
St.  Augustine,  and  retiring  with  thirteen 
companions  to  a  place  called  Premonstratum, 
or  Premontre,  a  secluded  and  marshy  valley 
in  the  forest  of  Coney,  he  there  began  his 
order,  about  the  year  1119.  This  ground, 
with  the  chapel  of  St.  John  Baptist,  was 
given  to  Norbert  by  the  bishop  of  Laon, 
with  the  approbation  of  Louis  le  Gros,  king 
of  France,  who  gave  the  Premonstratenses  a 
charter  of  privileges.  The  place  was  sup- 
posed by  some  to  have  been  called  Premon- 
stratum, because  the  Blessed  Virgin  herself 
foreshowed  (prasmonstravit)  this  place  for 
the  principal  house  of  the  order  in  a  vision 
and  at  the  same  time  commanded  them  to 
wear  a  white  habit,  but  the  name  seems  to 
have  existed  before  the  foundation  of  the 
monastery,  and  the  legend  was  probably 
invented  to  account  for  it. 

The  canons  of  this  order  were,  at  first,  so 
poor  that  they  had  nothing  they  could  call 
their  own  but  one  poor  ass,  which  served 
them  to  carry  wood,  which  they  cut  down 
every  morning  and  sent  to  Laon,  where  it 


PEESANCTIFIED 

was  sold  to  purchase  bread.  But  in  a  short 
time  they  received  so  many  donations,  and 
built  so  many  monasteries,  that,  thirty 
years  after  the  foundation  of  this  order,  they 
had  .above  one  hundred  abbeys  in  France 
and  Germany. 

The  popes  and  kings  of  France  have 
granted  many  privileges,  and  been  veiy 
liberal,  to  the  Premonstratenses.  Besides 
a  great  number  of  saints,  who  have  been 
canonized,  this  order  has  had  several  per- 
sons of  distinguished  birth,  who  have  been 
contented  with  the  humble  condition  of  lay- 
brothers  :  as,  Guy,  earl  of  Brienne ;  Godfrey, 
earl  of  Namur,  &o.  It  has  likewise  given 
the  Church  a  great  number  of  archbishops 
and  bishops.  The  founder  was  canonized 
by  Gregory  XIIL  in  1582. 

The  order  of  Premonstratenses  increased  so 
greatly,  that  it  had  monasteries  in  all  parts 
of  Christendom,  amounting  to  1000  abbeys, 
300  provostships,  a  vast  number  of  priories, 
and  500  nunneries.  These  were  divided 
into  30  cyrcaries  or  provinces.  But  this 
number  of  houses  is  greatly  diminished; 
for,  of  65  abbeys  it  had  in  Italy,  there  is 
not  one  remaining  at  present;  not  to- 
mention  the  loss  of  all  then-  monasteries  in 
Sweden,  Norway,  Denmark,  England,  Scot- 
land, and  Ireland. 

These  religious,  vulgarly  called  White 
Canons,  came  first  into  England  in  the  12th 
century,  where  their  first  monastery,  called 
New  House,  was  built  in  Lincolnshire,  a.d. 
1143,  by  Peter  de  Golsa  or  Goulsa,  and  de- 
dicated to  St.  Mary  and  St.  MartiaUs,  but 
the  Abbey  of  Welbeck  in  Nottinghamshire, 
founded  in  1153,  became  the  chief  house  of 
the  Order.  In  the  reign  of  Edward  I.,  when 
that  king  granted  his  protection  to  the  mon- 
asteries, the  Premonstratenses  had  twenty- 
seven  houses  in  this  kingdom.  —  Stubbs' 
Mosheim,  vol.  ii.  p.  122. 

PREROGATIVE  COURT.  The  Pre- 
rogative Court  of  the  archbishops  of  Canter- 
bury and  Armagh  was  that  court  wherein  all 
testaments  were  proved,  and  all  administra- 
tions granted,  when  a  party  dying  within 
the  province  had  bona  nOtabilia  in  some 
other  diocese  than  where  he  dies ;  and  was  so 
called  from  having  &  prerogative  throughout 
the  whole  province  for  the  said  purposes 
(See  Canons  92,  93,  &c.).  But  all  that  was 
abolished  by  the  new  Probate  Act  in  1857. 

PRESANCTIFIED.  It  was  an  early 
custom  to  abstain  from  celebration  of  H0I3' 
Communion  on  Good  Friday.  A  portion  of 
the  bread  consecrated  on  the  previous  day, 
Maundy-Thursday,  was  reserved  for  the 
communion  on  the  Friday,  and  the  wine  used 
was  unconsecrated.  This  was  called  the 
Mass  of  the  Presanctified  {Missa  Prxsancti- 
ficatorum).  The  idea  evidently  was  that 
the  Eucharist  is  a  feast,  and  therefore  not 


PRESBYTER 

to  be  celebrated  in  its  entirety  on  a  fast  day. 
The  Council  of  Laodicea  (Can.  49)  states 
that  bread  ought  not  to  be  offered  during 
Lent,  except  on  the  Sabbath,  and  the  Lord's 
day.     The  Council  in  Trullo,  a.d.  692,  orders 
the  use  of  the  rite  of  the  Presanctified  every 
day  in  Lent,  except  on  Saturday,  the  Lord's 
day,  and  the  feast  of  the  Annunciation  (Can. 
52).     On  this  rite  there  has  been  much  con- 
troversy between  ritualists  of  the  Eastern  and 
Western  Church,  into  which  it  is  not  ne- 
cessary here  to  enter  except  to  state  that  in 
the  Eastern  Church  this  service  is  observed 
all  Lent  long,  except  Saturdays  and  Sundays, 
and  the  Annunciation  of  the  Blessed  Virgin, 
which,   being    festivals,  are    exempt  from 
fasting ;  the  Greeks  being  of  opinion  that 
the  whole  Communion  service  is  not  to  be 
celebrated    on    fasting    days.      Upon   this 
account  they  charge  the  Latin  Church  with 
breach  of  the  canons,  because  they  celebrate 
the  Eucharist  in  Lent  as  they  do  the  rest  of 
the  year.  Good  Friday  excepted.     That  day 
the  liturgy  of  the  Presanctified  is  offered  in 
the  Latin  Church ;  the  priest  then  conse- 
crating neither  bread  nor  wine,  but  making 
use  of  the  bread  which  was  consecrated  the 
day  before,  and  communicating  only  under 
one  kind ;  for  the  wine  he  receives  is  only 
for  oblation,   being    unconsocrated.       The 
Greeks  do  the  same  thing,  from  whence  we 
may  conclude  that  they  communicate  only 
in  one  kind  during  Lent,  the   wine  that 
they  then  receive   being  not  consecrated. 
In  the  Church  of  England  there  is  no  such 
rite  as  that  of  the  "  presanctified,"  and  the 
appointment  of  a  special  epistle  and  gospel 
for  Good  Friday  would  seem  to   indicate 
that  a  Celebration  on  that  day  was  intended. 
Bishop  Andrewes,  in  his  sermons   on  the 
Passion,  speaks  in  such  a  way  that  there  is 
no  doubt  that  Celebrations  on  Good  Friday 
in  his  time  were  usual.     At  all  events  the 
Church  of  England  has  declared  decisively 
against  the  uncatholic  idea  of  communion 
by  the  priest  alone. — ^Bona,  Rer.  Liturg. 
1, 15,  5 ;  Leo  Allatius,  de  Eccl.  Occ.  et  Or. 
Perpetua  Consensione  ad  fin. ;  Neale's  Hist, 
of  East.  Church,  pt.  i  c.  vii. ;  Blunt's  P.  £.  i. 
p.  101.     [H.] 

PRESBYTER  (See  Bishop,  Deacon, 
Priest,  Orders,  Clergy).  The  name  npecr- 
Pvrepos  (elder)  is  a  word  borrowed  from  the 
Greek  translation  of  the  Old  Testament, 
which  commonly  signifies  a  ruler  or  go- 
vernor, being,  as  St.  Jerome  observes,  a  name 
of  office,  ncft  a  mere  indication  of  a  man's 
age;  for  elders  were  chosen,  not  for  their 
a^e,  but  for  their  merits  and  \rlsdom.  So 
that,  as  a  senator  among  the  Romans,  and 
an  alderman  in  our  own  language,  signifies 
a  person  of  a  certain  order  and  station  OTth- 
out  any  regard  to  age,  as  the  etymology  of 
the  term  would  indicate  ;  in  like  manner  a 


PRESBYTER 


609 


presbyter  or  elder  in  the  Christian  Church 
is  one  who  is  ordained  to  a  certain  office,  and 
authorised  by  his  quality,  not  his  a^e,  to 
discharge  the  several  duties  of  that  office  and 
station  in  which  he  is  placed.  In  this  large 
and  extensive  sense,  bishops  were  sometimes 
called  presbyters  in  the  New  Testament,  for 
the  apostles  themselves  did  not  refuse  that 
title.  On  the  other  hand,  it  is  clear  that 
presbyters  were  sometimes  called  bishops,  in 
the  general  sense  of  overseers  or  rulers  (see 
Acts  XX.  17  &  28,  Philipp.  i.  1),  while  bishops 
who  were  properly  such  were  distinguished 
by  other  titles,  as  that  of  chief  priests, 
apostles,  &c.  Bingham  shows,  however, 
that  those  who  maintained  the  identity  of 
the  names  did  not  thence  infer  identity  of 
offices,  but  always  esteemed  bishops  and 
presbyters  to  be  distinct  officers  {Antiq. 
bk.  ii.  c.  3). 

We  do  not  know  the  exact  period  at  which 
the  apostles  first  ordained  presbyters.  We 
do  not  read  of  their  existence  before  a.d. 
43,  when  the  disciples  at  Antioch  sent  their 
collections  to  the  presbyters  of  Judasa. 
About  A.D.  56,  St.  Paul  sent  for  "the 
presbyters  of  the  church  "  of  Ephesus  (Acts 
XX.  17)  ;  and  we  afterwards  read  of  bishops 
or  presbyters  at  Philippi  (Philipp.  i.  1)  ;  and 
the  directions  to  Timothy  (1  Tim.  ii.  and 
v.),  and  Titus  (Tit.  i.  5),  for  their  ordina- 
tion in  every  city ;  the  exhortation  of  St. 
Peter  to  "  the  presbyters ; "  and  of  St.  James 
(v.  14),  "is  any  one  sick  among  you,  let 
idm  send  for  the  presbyters  of  the  church ;  " 
suffice  to  prove  the  general  ordination  of 
presbyters  by  the  apostles. 

The  office  of  presbyters,  like  that  of 
bishops,  consisted  in  "  feeding  the  Church 
of  God,"  and  overseeing  it ;  exhorting  and 
convincing  the  gainsayers  by  sound  doctrine. 
Being  invested  with  the  power  of  teaching, 
they  also  possessed  authority  in  controversies. 
The  Church  of  Antioch  sent  to  Jerusalem  to 
consult  the  apostles  and  "  presbyterS "  on 
the  question  of  circumcision  (Acts  xv.);  and 
we  find  afterwards  that  heretics  were  some- 
times condemned  by  the  judgment  of  pres- 
byters, as  well  as  by  bishops  in  councils. 
They  possessed  in  their  degree  the  power  of 
remitting  or  retaining  sins  by  absolution, 
and  by  spiritual  censures.  They  must, 
even  at  the  beginning,  have  had  the  power 
of  baptizing  and  celebrating  the  Eucharist, 
of  performing  other  rites,  and  ofl'ering  up 
pubho  prayers  in  the  absence  of  the  apostles, 
or  by  their  permission ;  and  the  institution 
of  bishops  in  every  Church  by  the  apostles 
only  restrained  the  ordinary  exercise  of 
these  powers.  We  luiow  in  particular  from 
St.  James,  that  presbyters  had  authority  to 
visit  the  sick  and  offer  prayers,  anointing 
them  with  oil  for  the  recovery  of  their 
health.    From  the  time  of  the  apostles,  the 

2  B 


610 


PKESBYTEEIANS 


ofBce  of  public  teaching  in  tlie  Chuicli,  aud 
of  administering  the  sacraments,  was  always 
performed  by  the  bishop  or  presbyter,  unless 
in  cases  of  great  necessity.  The  power  of 
spiritual  jurisdiction  iu  each  Church,  of 
regulating  its  affairs  generally,  and  especially 
its  discipline,  was  shared  by  the  bishop  with 
the  presbyters,  who  also  instructed  and  ad- 
monished the  people  in  private.  The  pres- 
byters sat  on  seats  or  thrones  at  the  east  end 
of  the  church,  and  the  bishop  on  a  higher 
throne  in  the  midst  of  them.  In  some 
churches  they  laid  their  hands  with  the 
bishops  on  the  head  of  those  who  were  or- 
dained presbyters,  and  in  others  administered 
confirmation. 

The  wealth  and  temporal  power  of 
bishops  during  the  middle  ages  may  have 
induced  some  of  the  ignorant  to  suppose 
that  presbyters  were  exceedingly  inferior  to 
bishops ;  but  the  Catholic  Church,  which 
sees  with  the  eye  of  faith,  as  she  acknow- 
ledges the  same  sacred  dignity  of  the  priest- 
hood in  every  bishop,  whether  oppressed 
with  extreme  poverty,  or  whether  invested 
with  princely  dignity  and  wealth,  also  views 
the  greatness  and  the  sanctity  of  the  office 
of  presbyter  as  little  inferior  to  those  even  of 
the  chief  pastors  who  succeeded  the  apostles  ; 
and  the  Church  has  never  flourished  more, 
nor  has  the  episcopate  ever  been  held  in 
truer  reverence,  than  under  the  guidance  of 
those  apostolical  prelates  who,  like  St. 
Cyprian,  resolved  to  do  nothing  without  the 
consent  of  the  clergy,  and  who  have  sedu- 
lously avoided  even  the  appearance  of 
"  being  lords  over  God's  heritiage."  The 
spirit  of  a  genuine  Christianity  will  lead  the 
presbyters  to  reverence  and  obey  the 
bishops  as  their  fathers;  and  will  induce 
bishops  to  esteem  the  presbyters  as  fellow- 
workers  together  with  them,  and  brethren 
in  Jesus  Christ. — Bingham,  ii.  3 :  viii.  6 : 
xii.  2  ;  Palmer,  Orig.  Liturg.  ii.  p.  246 ; 
Walcott's  Ordinal,  Ivi. 

The  word  presbyter  was  substituted  for 
priest  in  the  Scotch  liturgy,  compiled  by 
Laud  in  the  reign  of  King  Charles  I.,  in 
1637 ;  which  never  came  into  use. 

PKES  BYT  BRIANS.  A  Protestant  sect, 
which  maintains  that  there  is  no  order  in 
the  Church  superior  to  presbyters,  and  on 
that  account  has  separated  from  the  Catholic 
Church.  It  was  founded  by  Calvin,  who 
established  the  system  at  Geneva,  a.d. 
1541.  In  a  modified  form  it  was  introduced 
into  Scotland,  under  the  influence  of  John 
Knox,  in  1560.  The  Geneva  form  was 
brought  in  by  Andrew  Melville  in  1592; 
and  this  sect  is  now  established  by  law  in 
Scotland,  where  there  nevertheless  exists  a 
national  branch  of  the  Catholic  Church, 
under  canonical  bishops  (See  Church  in 
Scotland), 


PRESBYTERIANS 

The  following  statement  is   taken  from 
the  Registrar's  return : 

"  The  Scottish  Kirk  adopts  the  Confession, 
Catechism,  and  Directory  ^prepared  by  the 
Westminster  Assembly  as  its  standards  of 
belief  and  worship.  Its  discipline  is  ad- 
ministered by  a  series  of  four  courts  or 
assemblies.  (1)  The  Kirle  Session  is  the 
lowest  court,  and  is  composed  of  the 
minister  of  a  parish  and  a  variable  number 
of  lay  elders,  appointed  fi-om  time  to  time 
by  the  session  itself.  (2)  The  Presbytery 
consists  of  representatives  from  a  certain 
number  of  contiguous  parishes,  associated 
together  in  one  district.  The  representa- 
tives are  the  ministers  of  all  such  parishes 
and  one  lay  elder  from  each.  This  assembly 
has  the  power  of  ordaining  ministers  and 
licensing  probationers  to  preach,  before  their 
ordination :  it  also  investigates  charges  re- 
specting the  conduct  of  members,  approves 
of  new  communicants,  and  pronounces  ex- 
communication against  offenders.  An  ap- 
peal, however,  lies  to  the  next  superior 
court;  viz.  (3)  The  Provincial  Synod, 
which  comprises  several  presbyteries,  aud  is 
constituted  by  the  ministers  and  elders  by 
whom  these  presbyteries  themselves  were 
last  composed.  (4)  The  General  Assembly 
is  the  highest  court,  and  is  composed  of 
representatives  (ministers  and  elders)  from 
the  presbyteries,  royal  burghs,  and  universi- 
ties of  Scotland,  to  the  number  (at  present) 
of  363 ;  of  which  number  rather  more  than 
two-fifths  are  laymen. 

"The  National  Church  of  Scotland  has 
three  presbyteries  in  England ;  that  of 
London,  containing  five  congregations, — 
that  of  Liverpool  and  Maiichester,  contain- 
iug  three  congregations, — and  that  of  the 
North  of  England,  containing  eight  con- 
gregations. 

"Various  considerable  secessions  have 
from  time  to  time  occurred  in  Scotland 
from  the  National  Church,  of  bodies  which, 
while  holding  Presbyterian  sentiments,  dis- 
sent from  the  particular  mode  in  which 
they  are  developed  by  the  Established  Kirk, 
especially  protesting  against  the  mode  in 
which  Church  patronage  is  administered 
and  against  the  undue  interference  of  the 
civil  power.  The  principal  of  these  seced- 
ing bodies  are, — the  '  United  Presbyterian 
Church,'  and  the '  Free  Cliurch  of  Scotland : ' 
the  former  being  an  amalgamation  (effected 
in  1847)  of  the  '  Secession  Church  '  (which 
separated  in  1732)  with  the  '  Relief  Synod ' 
(which  seceded  in  1752) ;  and  the  latter 
having  been  constituted  in  1843. 

"  The  '  United  Presbyterian  Church '  has 
five  presbyteries  in  England,  containing 
seventy-six  congregations  ;  of  which,  how- 
ever, fourteen  are  locally  in  Scotland, 
leaving  the  number  locally  in  England  62. 


PRESBYTEEIUM 

"  The  '  Free  Church  of  Scotland '  has  no 
ramifications,  under  that  name,  in  England  ; 
but  various  Presbyterian  congregations 
which  accord  in  all  respects  with  that 
community,  and  which,  before  the  disrup- 
tion of  1843,  were  in  union  with  the  Estab- 
lished Kirk,  compose  a  separate  Presby- 
terian body  under  the  appellation  of  the 
■*  Presbyterian  Cliurch  in  Ewiland,'  having, 
in  this  portion  of  Great  Britain,  seven 
presbyteries  and  eighty-three  congrega- 
tions." 

PRESBYTEKIUM,  or  PEESBYTERY. 
The  space  in  collegiate  and  large  churches 
between  the  easternmost  stalls  of  the  choir 
and  the  altar.  As  the  word  implies,  it  was 
the  place  assigned  for  the  bishop  and  pres- 
byters, and  none  else  were  admitted  to  it. — 
Ducange,  s.  v. 

PRESENCE  (See  Real  Presence). 

PRESENTATION  (see  Patron  and 
Benefice)  is  the  offering  of  a  clerk  to  the 
bishop  by  a  patron  of  the  benefice.  It 
■differs  from  nomination  in  this,  that  while 
presentation  signifies  the  offering  a  clerk 
ito  the  bishop  for  institution,  nomination 
signifies  offering  a  clerk  to  the  patron  in 
•order  that  he  may  be  presented. 

PRIEST  (See  Orders,  Ordinations, 
Presbyter,  Sacrifice,  and  Absolution).  The 
word  ^^ priest"  is  evidently  derived  from 
'"presbyter."  Our  ancestors,  the  Saxons, 
first  used  preoster :  whence,  by  further 
■contraction,  came  preste  and  priest.  The 
High  and  Low  Dutch  have  priester ;  the 
French,  prester  [now  contracted  into  pre- 
tre] ;  the  Italian  prete ;  but  the  Spaniard 

•  only  speaks  {\A\,  presbytero. 

The  English  word  priest,  although  de- 
:rived  from  presbyter,  an  elder,  corresjMnds 
more  closely  in  meaning  with  the  Greek 
•and  Latin  words  Upevs,  sacerdos,  which  are 
•derived  from  words  that  signify  holy:  and 
so  the  word  priest  signifies  him  whose  charge 
and  function  is  about  holy  things;  and 
•therefore  seems  to  be  a  most  proper  name 
for  him  who  is  set  apart  to  the  holy  public 
-service  and  worshiji  of  God,  especially 
when  he  is  in  the  actual  ministration  of 
holy  things.  If  it  is  objected  that,  ac- 
■  cording  to  the  usual  acceptation  of  the 
word,  it  signifies  him  that  offers  up  a  sa- 
crifice, and  therefore  cannot  be  allowed  to 
;  a  minister  of  the  gospel,  who  has  no  sa- 
crifice to  offer,  it  is  answered,  that  the 
ministers  of  the  gospel  have  sacrifices  to 

•  offer  (1  St.  Pet.  ii.  5) ;  "  Ye  are  built  up  a 
spiritual  house,  an  holy  priesthood,  to  offer 
up  spiritual  sacrifices"  of  prayer,  praises, 
thanksgiving,  &c.  In  respect  of  these,  the 
ministers  of  the  gospel  may  safely,  in  a 
metaphorical  sense,  be  called  priests ;  and 
in  a  more  eminent  manner  than  other  Ohris- 

itians,  because  they  are  taken  from  among 


PRIEST 


CU 


men  to  offer  up  these  spiritual  sacrifices  for 
others.  But  besides  these  spiritual  sacri- 
fices mentioned,  the  ministers  of  the  gospel 
have  another  sacrifice  to  offer,  viz.  the  "  un- 
bloody sacrifice,"  as  it  was  anciently  called, 
the  commemorative  sacrifice  of  the  blood  of 
Christ,  which  does  as  really  and  truly  show 
forth  the  death  of  Christ,  as  those  sacrifices 
under  the  law  did ;  and  in  respect  of  this 
sacrifice  of  the  Eucharist,  the  ancients  have 
usually  called  those  that  offer  it  up,  priests. 
— Fludyer's  Comm. 

That  it  might  not  be  doubted  by  whom 
the  foi'm  of  absolution  may  be  pronounced, 
the  rubric  expressly  informs  us  that  it  is 
the  priest  who  officiates.  By  priest,  in 
Church  language,  is  understood  a  person 
who  is  advanced  in  the  ecclesiastical  orders 
to  the  dignity  of  a  presbyter  ;  and  no 
person,  in  any  age  of  the  Church,  who  was 
under  this  degree,  did  ever  pretend,  as 
of  right,  to  pronounce  absolution.  The 
penitentiaries,  in  the  ancient  and  more 
modern  ages  of  the  Church,  were  always  of 
this  degree.  It  was  adopted  into  an  axiom 
in  the  canon  law,  "  ejus  est  absolvere  cujus 
est  ligare."  No  one  could  pronounce  ab- 
solution but  he  who  had  power  to  excom- 
municate. In  the  body  of  that  law,  absolu- 
tions of  all  kinds  are  reserved  either  to 
presbyters  or  bishops ;  and  in  our  provincial 
constitutions  it  is  strictly  enjoined,  "de 
pcenitentia  prajcipimus  quod  diaooni  pceni- 
tentias  dare  non  presumant,"  unless  the 
priest  be  away  when  a  man  is  dying. — 
Lyndwood.  Our  Church,  in  the  last  review 
of  the  liturgy,  has  chosen  to  put  in  the 
word  priest  instead  of  minister  (which  was 
in  King  Edward  VI.'s  Second  Book,  and  in 
Queen  Elizabeth's),  to  the  end  that  no  one 
might  pretend  to  pronounce  this  but  one  in 
priest's  orders ;  being  sensible  that  some 
bold  innovations  have  been  made  herein,  by 
reason  of  some  persons  misunderstanding  or 
misapplying  the  word  minister.  But  the 
first  compilers  of  the  Common  Prayer  under- 
stood the  same  by  minister  as  we  do  now 
by  priest,  that  being  the  general  acceptation 
of  the  word  at  that  time.  The  compilers  of 
the  Second  Book  of  Edward  VI.  (in  which 
the  Confession  and  Absolution  were  first 
inserted)  put  into  the  rubric,  "  to  be  pro- 
nounced by  the  minister  "  (or  priest)  "  alone" 
to  avoid  the  imputation  which  the  Papists 
had  charged  some  of  the  reformed  with,  for 
permitting  absolution  to  be  pronounced  by 
persons  not  of  this  order.  For  in  the  pro- 
vincial Council  of  Sens,  a.d.  1528,  which 
was  before  that  of  Trent,  and  twenty  years 
before  the  compiling  our  Common  Prayer, 
we  find  the  Prostestants  found  fault  with  for 
affirming,  that  laics  and  women  among  them 
might  pronounce  special  absolution  ;  which 
indeed  was  Luther's  opinion,  but  only  so  (as 

2  B  2 


612 


PRIEST 


Cliemnitius  explains  it)  that,  in  case  of  ex- 
treme necessity  they  might  use  it ;  which 
doctrine  he  had  from  the  Papists  themselves. 
— Nicholls,  Oomm.  of  Common  Prayer: 
note  to  Evening  Service.  It  is  more  prob- 
able  that  the  "alone"  meant  without  the 
congregation,  who  had  been  saying  the 
Confession.  But  the  universal  practice  is 
sufficient  to  establish  the  other  interpreta- 
tion now. 

In  the  diocese  of  Alexandria,  the  privilege 
of  giving  absolution  to  great  criminals  and 
scandalous  offenders  was  reserved  to  the 
patriarch ;  as  appears  in  the  case  of  Lam- 
ponianus,  an  excommunicated  presbyter. 
"He  expressed  his  repentance  with  tears," 
said  Theophilus  the  patriarch,  "and  the 
people  interceded  for  him,  yet  I  refused  to 
absolve  him  ;  only  assuring  this,  that  if  he 
should  be  in  manife.st  danger  of  death,  any 
presbyter  should  receive  him  into  com- 
munion by  my  order."  And  in  general,  in 
the  primitive  Church,  the  granting  absolu- 
tion to  reconcile  penitents,  was  the  bishop's 
sole  •  prerogative,  and  rarely  committed  to 
presbyters ;  but  never  to  deacons,  except  in 
cases  of  extreme  necessity,  when  neither 
bishop  nor  presbyter  was  at  hand. — Bing- 
ham, ii.  17  ;  TUlem.  Mem.  xii.  546. 

The  privilege  was  also  allowed  in  times 
of  persecution,  to  martyrs  and  confessors  in 
prison ;  but  then  they  always  signified  what 
they  had  done  to  the  bishop  (See  Cave's 
Prim.  Clmrdi). 

At  the  last  review  of  the  Common  Prayer 
Book,  A.D.  1661,  the  Presbyterian  divines 
requested  that  "  as  the  word  minister,  and 
not  priest  or  curate,  is  used  in  the  Ab- 
solution, and  in  divers  other  places,  it  may 
throughout  the  whole  book  be  so  used, 
instead  of  those  two  words."  To  which  the 
Episcopalian  commissioners  replied,  that 
"  it  is  not  reasonable  the  word  minister 
should  be  only  used  in  the  liturgy.  For 
since  some  parts  of  the  liturgy  may  be 
performed  by  a  deacon,  and  others,  such  as 
absolution  and  consecration,  by  none  under 
the  order  of  a  priest,  it  is  fit  that  some  such 
word  as  priest  should  be  used  for  those 
offices,  and  not  minister,  which  signifies  at 
large  every  one  that  ministers  in  that  holy 
office,  of  what  order  soever  he  be."  Ac- 
cordingly the  word  "priest"  in  its  exclusive 
sense,  and  in  contradistinction  to  the  word 
deacon,  was  inserted,  and  the  sense  of  the 
Church  of  England  on  this  subject,  ascer- 
tained through  the  objection  made  by  the 
Presbyterian  divines,  was  adopted  and  rati- 
fied by  the  act  of  parliament. 

In  the  primitive  Church,  the  deacons 
were  ranked  among  the  "sacred  orders;" 
and  though  their  office  has  not  always  been 
so  accuratelj'  defined  as  that  of  the  pres- 
byters, or  priests,   yet  in  the   Church   of 


PRIMATE 

England  they  are  to  most  purposes  con- 
sidered as  an  inferior  degree  of  "  the  priest- 
hood." Their  duties  are  laid  down  in  the 
office  of  "  the  Form  and  Manner  of  making 
Deacons ; "  and,  "  for  the  resolution  of  all 
doubts,"  the  preface  to  the  Book  of  Com- 
mon Prayer  has  wisely  directed,  that  "  the 
parties  that  so  doubt,  or  diversely  take 
anything,  shall  always  resort  to  the  bishop 
of  the  diocese,  who  by  his  discretion  shall 
take  order  for  the  quieting  and  appeasing  of 
the  same ;  so  that  the  same  order  be  not 
contrary  to  anything  contained  in  this 
book." 

PRIEST'S  INTENTION  (See  Inten- 
tion'). 

PRIMATE  (See  Archbishop;  Metro- 
politan ;  Patriarcli).  In  the  Christian  hier- 
archy, or  scheme  of  Chm-ch  government. 
Primates  are  such  bishops  of  a  province  as 
preside  over  the  rest. 

I.  Some  derive  the  original  of  primates  or 
metropolitans  from  apostolical  constitution. 
But  it  may  be  doubted  whether  the  apostles 
made  any  such  general  settlement  in  every 
province ;  and  the  records  of  the  original  of 
most  churches  being  lost,  it  can  never  be 
proved  that  they  did.  It  is  most  probable 
that  this  order  of  bishops  commenced  not 
long  after  theapostolic  age,  when  sects  and 
schisms  began  to  break  in  apace,  and  con- 
troversies multiplying  between  particular 
bishops,  it  was  found  necessary  to  pitch 
upon  one  in  every  province,  to  whom  the- 
decision  of  cases  might  be  referred,  and  by 
whom  all  common  and  public  affairs  might 
be  directed.  Or,  it  might  take  its  rise  from 
that  common  respect  and  deference  which 
was  usually  paid  by  the  rest  of  the  bishops 
to  the  bishop  of  the  metropolis,  or  capital- 
city,  of  each  province  :  which,  advancing 
into  a  custom,  was  afterwards  settled  by  a 
canon  of  the  Council  of  Nice. — Gone.  Nic^ 
c.  6. 

The  offices  and  privileges  of  primates  or 
metropolitans  were  as  follows.  (1)  They 
were  to  regulate  the  elections  of  all  their 
provincial  bishops,  and  either  ordain  or 
authorise  the  ordination  of  them :  and  no- 
election  or  ordination  of  bishops  was  valid 
without  their  approbation.  Nor  was  this 
power  at  all  infringed  by  setting  up  the 
patriarchs  above  them.  For,  though  the 
metropolitans  were  to  be  ordained  by  the 
patriarchs,  yet  still  the  right  of  ordaining 
their  own  suffragans  was  preserved  to  them. 
It  is  to  be  observed,  that  this  power  was  not 
arbitrary  :  for  the  primates  had  no  negative 
voice  in  the  matter,  but  were  to  be  deter- 
mined and  concluded  by  the  major  part  of  a 
provincial  synod. — Gone.  Nic.  c,  6 ;  Gone. 
Laod.  c.  12 ;  Cone.  Chalced.  c.  16. 

(2)  They  had  to  preside  over  the  provincial 
bishops,    and,    if   any  controversies    arose 


PEIMATB 

amoug  them,  to  interpose  tlieir  authority  to 
•end  and  decide  them:  also  to  hear  the 
accusations  of  others,  who  complained  of 
injury  done  to  them  by  their  own  bishops, 
from  whom  there  was  always  liberty  of 
appeal  to  the  metropolitan.  But  still  there 
lay  an  appeal  from  the  metropolitan  to  a 
provincial  synod,  of  which  he  was  only  the 
jDresident  or  moderator. — Cone.  Milev.  c.  21; 
Cone.  Carth.  3,  can.  7;  Cod.  Just.  lib.  i.  4, 
c.  29. 

(3)  It  was  their  duty  to  call  provincial 
synods,  and  preside  in  them.  To  this  end 
their  circular  letters,  called  Synodisi  and 
Tractorise  were  a  legal  summons,  which  no 
liishop  of  the  province  might  disobey  under 
pain  of  suspension,  or  other  canonical  cen- 
sure, at  the  discretion  of  the  metropolitan 
and  council. — Cone.  Nie.  c.  3 ;  Cone.  An- 
tioeh.  c.  20,  &c. 

(4)  It  belonged  to  the  primates  to  publish 
and  disperse  such  imperial  laws  and  canons, 
as  were  made  either  by  the  emperors  or  the 
councils,  for  the  common  good  of  the  Church. 
This  gave  them  a  right  to  visit,  and  inquire 
into  neglects,  abuses,  and  disorders,  com- 
mitted by  any  bishop  throughout  the  whole 
province. — Justin."  Novel.  6,  42;  Cone.  An- 
tiocli.  c.  9. 

(5)  Bishops,  when  they  travelled  into 
foreign  countries  on  extraordinary  occasions, 
nsed  to  consult  the  primate,  and  take  his 
Formatai,  or  letters  of  commendation.  This 
was  particularly  required  of  the  African 
bishops  by  the  third  Council  of  Carthage. — 
Cone.  Carth.  3,  c.  28. 

(6)  Primates  were  to  take  care  of  all 
vacant  sees  within  their  province,  by  ad- 
ministering the  affairs  of  the  Church,  secur- 
ing the  revenues  of  the  bishopric,  and 
procuring  a  speedy  election  of  a  new  bishop. 
— Cone.  Cartli.  5,  c.  8. 

(7)  It  belonged  to  the  metropolitans 
yearly  to  review  the  calculation  of  the  time 
of  Easter,  and  give  notice  to  their  suffragans 
of  it.  St.  Ambrose  did  this  for  the  province 
of  Milan,  and  the  bishop  of  Carthage  for 
that  of  Africa. — Ambrose,  E]}.  83;  Cone, 
Carth.  3.  c.  1.  The  care  of  composing  the 
•cycle  was,  indeed,  by  the  Nicene  Fathers 
particularly  committed  to  the  bishop  of 
Alexandria.  But  due  care  not  being  always 
taken  in  this  matter,  the  metropolitan  in 
■every  province  was  concerned  to  settle  the 
time,  and  acquaint  the  whole  province  with 
it. 

II.  The  primate  of  Alexandria  was  the 
•greatest  metropolitan  m  the  world,  both  for 
the  absoluteness  of  his  power,  and  the 
■extent  of  his  jurisdiction.  For  he  was  not 
metropolitan  of  a  single  province,  but  of  all 
the  provinces  of  Egypt,  Libya,  and  Penta- 
polis,  in  which  there  were  at  least  six 
large  provinces,   out   of  which  above    an 


PEIME 


613 


hundred  bishops  were  called  to  a  provincial 
synod. 

Besides  an  actual  primacy  of  power,  there 
was  likewise  a  primacy  of  honour ;  that  is, 
some  bishops  had  the  name  and  title  of 
primates,  but  not  the  jurisdiction.  Of  these 
there  were  three  sorts.  (1)  The  senior 
bishops  in  each  province,  next  to  the  metro- 
poUtan.  These  primates  had  no  power 
above  others,  except  when  the  metropolitans 
were  some  way  disabled,  or  disquaUfied  for 
discharging  their  office,  by  irregularity  or 
suspension.  In  this  case,  their  power  de- 
volved on  the  senior  bishop  of  the  ^iro- 
vince. 

(2)  Another  sort  of  honorary  primates 
were  the  titular  metropiolitans,  or  bishops  of 
such  cities  as  had  the  name  and  title  of 
metropolis  bestowed  on  them  by  some 
emperor,  without  the  privileges,  which  were 
still  continued  to  the  ancient  metropolis  of 
the  ijrovince.  Of  this  sort  were  the  cities 
of  Chalcedon  and  Nice. 

(3)  Some  bishops  were  honoured  with 
the  title  of  primates,  in  regard  to  the 
eminency  of  their  see,  being  some  mother- 
church,  or  particularly  honoured  by  ancient 
prescription.  This  was  the  case  of  the 
liishop  of  Jerusalem,  in  consideration  of  its 
being  the  mother-church  of  the  Christian 
world. — Cone.  Nie.  can.  7;  Bingham,  ii.  c.  16. 

III.  The  division  of  England  into  two 
provinces,  Canterbury  and  York,  occasioned 
the  introduction  of  primacies  among  us. 
Canterbury,  which  was  the  original  metro- 
polis, gives  to  its  bishop  the  title  of  Primate 
of  all  England ;  York,  only  that  of  Primate 
of  England.  Accordingly,  the  former  has 
some  jurisdiction  over  all  England,  which 
the  latter  has  only  in  his  own  province. 
(See  Archbishop.) 

The  archbishop  of  Armagh  is  primate 
of  all  Ireland;  of  Dublin,  that  of  Ireland. 
Until  the  suppression  of  some  of  the  Irish 
sees  in  1833,  the  archbishop  of  Cashel 
was  primate  of  Munster  ;  of  Tuam,  primate 
of  Connaught.  The  archbishop  of  St.  An- 
drew's was  primate  of  Scotland.  Now  a 
Primus  is  elected  by  the  other  bishops  on  a 
vacancy.  The  archbishop  of  Beims  is 
primate  of  France ;  of  Eouen,  primate  of 
Normandy ;  of  Lyons,  primate  of  Gaul ;  of 
Toledo,  primate  of  Spain,  &c. 

PRIME  (Lat.  primus )  :  the  first  hour 
of  the  day,  i.e.  6  a.m.  Amongst  many 
early  writers  Tertullian  speaks  of  the  openmg 
and  close  of  each  day  as  the  chief  times  of 
prayer,  though  between  them  the  3rd,  6th, 
and  9th,  or  "  ApostoHc  hours,"  are  to  be  ob- 
served (De  Orat.  ix.  26).  St.  Cyprian  also 
says,  "  besides  the  hours  of  ancient  time 
observed.  .  .  in  the  morning,  we  must  pray  " 
(J3e  Orat.  Bom.  xxii.) ;  and  the  so-called 
■Apostohc  Constitutions  lay  down  the  rule  : 


614 


PKIMER 


"Offer  prayers — in  the  morning  giving 
thanlvs  that  the  Lord  has  sent  you  light, 
that  He  has  brousht  you  past  the  night, 
and  brought  on  the  day"  (viii.  34).  Of 
what  the  office  for  prime  consisted  in  the 
primitive  times  no  account  has  been  handed 
down.  The  first  authoritative  form  is  that 
of  St.  Benedict  (a.d.  530) ;  but  there  can  be 
no  doubt  that  he  grounded  his  service  on 
older  forms  (See  Freeman's  Prin.  Div. 
Serv.  i.  65, 106).     [H.] 

PKIMER  (See  Prymer). 

PBIMICERIUS,  defined  by  Suicer  as  "  qui 
in  primS,  cerfi.  hajres  scriptus,"  one  who  is 
designated  as  the  principal  heir ;  that  is  to 
say,  the  head  of  an  ecclesiastical  corporation. 
Ducange  defines  the  officer  as  "primus  in 
ceram  relatus,"  i.e.  the  first  on  the  wax 
tablet  or  roll  (s.  v.).  Hence  it  came  to 
signify  one  who  presided  over  any  particular 
department ;  the  chief  notary,  for  instance, 
was  called  npififuKrjptos  voTaptcav  '.  and  so  the 
chief  reader,  the  chief  chanter,  &c.,  in  great 
churches.  Gregoiy  the  Great  thus  uses  the 
word,  directing  the  property  of  a  vacant  see 
to  be  entrusted  for  safe  keeping  to  the 
deacon  and  the  primicerius  of  the  notaries 
(Epist.  iii.  22).  It  is  the  title  of  a  dignitary 
in  several  Italian  cathedrals,  and  is  sup- 
posed to  answer  to  our  chancellor;  a  name 
not  used  in  Italy  as  that  of  a  cathedral 
officer.  In  1226  the  precentor  of  York  was 
addressed  as  primicerius  by  Honoriiis  III. 
(Walcott,  Sac.  Arch.  p.  470).  The  pre- 
centor of  Aberdeen  cathedral  was  anciently 
caUed  Primicerius,  as  Kennedy  states  in  his 
Annals  of  Aberdeen. 

PRIMITIVE  CHURCH  (See  Tradi- 
tion). The  Church  as  it  existed  iu  the  ages 
immediately  after  its  first  establishment. 
From  its  near  connexion  with  the  ajxistles 
and  other  inspired  men,  the  primitive 
Church  enjoyed  many  advantages,  of  which, 
at  later  periods,  it  was  deprived.  To  the 
earliest  ages  we  naturally  look  for  illustra- 
tions of  obscurities  in  the  New  Testament, 
for  evidence  and  testimony  of  matter  of 
fact,  for  sound  interpretations  of  doctrine, 
for  proofs  of  the  efficacy  of  the  gospel,  and 
for  examples  of  undaunted  Christian  hero- 
ism. Hence  the  value  we  are  accustomed 
to  attach  to  the  writings  which  have  come 
down  to  us  from  the  first  three  centuries 
after  Christ ;  and  this  value  is  considerably 
enhanced  by  the  fervour,  the  beauty,  and 
the  surpassing  eloquence  which  adorned  the 
Church  in  that  early  day,  and  in  the  ages 
following.  We  may  give  an  instance  in 
the  case  of  infant  baptism,  which  one  sect 
of  Christians  of  the  present  day  deny  to  be 
requisite.  The  primitive  Church  held 
quite  a  different  view.  In  the  Holy  Scrip- 
tures we  read  of  whole  households  being 
baptized,  which  is  indirect  testimony  as  to 


PEIORY 

the  baptizing  of  infants.  Our  Lord's  owi^ 
words  with  regard  to  little  children  being- 
brought  to  Him,  is  a  strong  testimony  tO' 
the  reception  of  infants  in  the  Church  ;  and 
this  was  realized  in  the  primitive  Church. 
Justin  Martyr  (a.d.  148)  Avrites  that  in  his- 
time  there  were  many  who  had  been  made 
disciples  of  Christ  from  their  infancy ;  and 
Irena3us  (a.d.  170)  speaks  clearly  of"  infants 
and  little  children  "  being  born  anew  to  God 
in  Holy  Baptism  (adv.  Hssres.  ii.  22,  al.  38). 
St.  Cyprian  (a.d.  250)  also  wrote  an  epistle 
to  the  effect  that  no  infant  was  too  young  to 
be  baptized  (Ep.  Ixiv.) ;  and  St.  Augustine  i& 
explicit  about  this  matter  (Aug.  Serm.  174, 
176,  &c.).  On  such  matters  we  refer  to  the 
usages  of  the  primitive  Church,  and  these 
were  familiarly  known  to  the  Reformers  of 
the  Church  of  England ;  and,  having  taken 
the  primitive  Church  as  their  model,  and  as 
the  isest  witness  of  Catholic  principles  and 
usages,  they  transfused  its  spirit,  not  only 
into  the  liturgy,  but  into  the  whole  frame- 
work and  superstructure  of  that  venerable- 
fabric  they  aimed  to  restore.  How  welE 
they  succeeded  is  evidenced  in  that  fear- 
less appeal  which  Catholics  ever  make,  first 
to  the  Apostolic  Church,  then  to  those  who 
drew  their  principles  from  it  along  with 
their  infant  breath,  and  fiourished  and  died 
in  an  age  when  inspiration  itself  was- 
scarcely  extinct.  That  Church  has  nothing 
to  dread  which  can  lay  its  standards  on  the- 
altar  of  antiquity,  and  return  them  to  hcF 
bosom,  signed  with  the  glorious  testimony 
of  a  Polycarp,  an  Ignatius,  a  Clement,  and 
a  "  noble  army  of  martyrs ; "  nothing  has 
she  to  dread  but  the  possibility  of  de- 
clension, and  unfaithfulness  to  her  sacred 
trust. 

PRIOR  (See  Monh).  The  head  or 
superior  of  a  convent  of  monks  where  there 
was  no  abbot.  Where  there  was  one  the 
prior  was  the  next  person  after  the  abbot. 

PRIORY  (See  Monastery).  A  house 
occupied  by  a  society  of  monks  or  nuns, 
the  chief  of  whom  was  termed  a  prior  or 
.prioress  ;  and  of  these  there  were  two  sorts  r 
first,  where  the  prior  was  chosen  by  the 
convent,  and  governed  as  independently 
as  any  abbot  in  his  abbey ;  such  were  tlie 
cathedral  priors,  and  most  of  those  of  the 
Augustine  order.  Secondly,  where  tlie 
priory  was  a  cell  subordinate  to  some  great 
abbey,  and  the  prior  was  placed  or  dis- 
placed at  the  will  of  the  abbot.  Bufc 
there  was  a  considerable  difference  in  the 
regulation  of  these  cells;  for  some  were 
altogether  subject  to  their  respective  ab- 
bots, who  sent  what  officers  and  monks 
they  pleased,  and  took  their  revenues  into 
the  common  stock  of  the  abbeys ;  whilst 
others  consisted  of  a  stated  number  of 
monks,  under  a  prior  sent   to  them   from 


PEISCA,  ST. 

the  superior  abbey,  and  those  priories 
paid  a  pension  yearly,  as  an  acknowledg- 
ment of  their  subjection,  but  acted  In 
other  matters  as  independent  bodies,  and 
had  the  rest  of  their  revenues  for  their  own 
iise.  The  priories  or  cells  were  always  of 
the  same  order  as  the  abbeys  on  which 
they  depended,  though  sometimes  their 
inmates  were  of  a  different  sex ;  it  being 
usual,  after  the  Norman  Conquest,  for  the 
great  abbeys  to  build  nunneries  on  some 
of  their  manors,  which  should  be  subject 
to  their  visitation. 

Alien  priories  were  cells  or  small  re- 
ligious houses  in  our  country,  dependent 
on  large  foreign  monasteries.  They  were 
established  by  Archbishop  Robert  a.d. 
1051.  When  manors  or  tithes  were  given 
to  distant  religious  houses,  the  monks,  either 
to  increase  the  authority  of  their  own  order, 
or  perhaps  rather  to  have  faithful  stewards 
of  their  revenues,  built  convenient  houses 
for  the  reception  of  small  fraternities  of  their 
body,  who  were  deputed  to  reside  at  and 
govern  those  cells  (See  Hook's  Arch- 
bishops, i.  498 :  iv.  488 :  vi.  62). 

PKISCA,  ST.  Commemorated  in  our 
Calendar  on  January  13.  The  legend  is  that 
she  was  thrown  to  the  lions  in  the  amphithea- 
tre,but  that  they  did  not  harm  her,  crouching 
down  at  her  feet.  She  was  then  beheaded, 
and  an  eagle  hovered  over  her  lifeless  form, 
tiU  she  was  laid  in  her  grave.  She  is 
therefore  represented  in  ancient  pictures 
with  a  sword  in  her  hand,  a  lion  crouching  at 
her  feet,  and  an  eagle  hovering  above  her 
head.     [H.] 

PfilSCILLIANISTS.  Certain  heretics 
whose  founder  was  PriscilUan,  a  Spaniard 
of  noble  extraction,  very  wealthy,  and 
endued  with  much  wit,  learning,  and  elo- 
quence. Mark,  an  Egyptian  heretic,  hav- 
ing sown  the  errors  of  Gnosticism  in  Graul, 
went  into  Spain,  where  carnal  pleasure, 
which  was  the  principal  article  of  his  doc- 
trine, procured  him  quickly  a  great  many 
disciples,  the  chief  whereof  was  PriscUhan, 
who  covered  his  vanity  under  the  appear- 
ance of  a  profound  humility.  He  taught, 
besides  the  abominations  of  the  Gnostics, 
that  the  soul  was  of  the  same  substance 
with  God,  and  that,  descending  to  the 
earth,  through  seven  heavens,  and  certain 
other  degrees  of  principality,  it  fell  into 
the  hands  of  the  evil  one,  who  put  it  into 
the  body,  which  he  made  to  consist  of 
twelve  parts,  over  each  of  which  presided 
a  celestial  sign.  He  condemned  the  eat- 
ing of  the  flesh  of  animals,  and  marriage 
as  an  unlawful  copulation,  and  separated 
women  from  their  husbands  without  their 
consent ;  and,  according  to  his  doctrine, 
man's  will  was  subject  to  the  power  of  the 
stars.     He  confounded  the  holy  persons  in 


PRIVATE  BAPTISM 


615 


the  Trinity,  like  Sabellius,  ordered  his 
followers  to  fast  on  Sundays  and  Christmas 
Day,  because  he  believed  Christ  had  not 
taken  true  flesh  upon  Him.  Lying,  a  most 
abominable  vice,  and  so  contrary  to  the 
God  of  truth,  was  a  thing  tolerated  amongst 
his  followers.  There  was  a  volume  com- 
posed by  them  called  Libra,  because  that  in 
the  twelve  questions  in  it,  as  in  twelve 
ounces,  their  whole  doctrine  was  explained. 
PriscilUan  broached  his  heresy  in  the  fourth 
century.  He  was  put  to  death,  with  some 
of  his  followers,  at  Treves,  in  385,  by 
order  of  the  usurper  Maximus,  contrary  to 
the  earnest  instance  of  St.  Martin,  bishop 
of  Tours.  This  was  the  first  instance  of 
the  infliction  of  death  for  heresy,  and  at  the 
time  excited  universal  horror  among  Chris- 
tians, St.  Ambrose  refused  to  communi- 
cate with  the  bishops  who  had  taken  part 
in  it,  and  a  synod  at  Turin  excommunicated 
them. — Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  314;  Newman's 
Fleury,  bk.  xviii.  29,  note. 

PRIVATE  BAPTISM.  In  the  ancient 
manuals  of  the  Church  of  England,  the 
rubrics  simply  ordered  that  in  cases  of  ex- 
treme danger  the  words  "  in  the  Name  of 
the  Father,  and  of  the  Son,  and  of  the  Holy 
Ghost"  should  be  used,  with  aspersion  of 
the  water.  Other  prayers  were  not  en- 
joined. By  a  canon  of  JSlfric  (a.d.  957), 
children,  if  sick,  were  to  be  brought  to  the 
priest,  who  was  to  baptize  them  from  what 
district  soever  they  were  brought.  The 
Council  of  Winchester  (1071)  and  the  Con- 
stitutions of  Othobon  (1268)  order  that  an 
infant,  if  in  danger,  shall  be  baptized  on  the 
day  of  its  birth.  The  vessel  used  in  private 
baptism  was  by  Langton's  Constitutions 
(a.d.  1223)  to  be  carried  to  the  church,  and 
not  be  used  for  any  common  purpose.  Ac- 
cording to  Edmund's  Constitutions  (1236) 
it  was  to  be  large  enough  to  allow  of  im- 
mersion, and  might  afterwards  be  deputed 
"  to  the  use  of  the  church,"  which  Lynd- 
wood  explains  "  for  washing  the  church 
linen."  The  water  that  had  been  used  was 
to  be  thrown  into  the  fire,  or  carried  to  the 
church,  and  placed  in  the  font. 

In  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549  the  person 
baptizing  was  directed  to  "  call  upon  God 
for  His  grace ;  and  say  the  Lord's  Prayer,  if 
the  time  suffice."  In  1661  Bishop  Cosin 
suggested  an  addition,  namely,  that  after 
calling  upon  God,  and  the  recital  of  the 
Lord's  Prayer,  "  so  many  of  the  collects 
appointed  to  be  said  before  in  the  form  of 
Public  Baptism,  as  the  time  and  exigence 
will  suffer,"  shall  be  used.  As  the  rubric 
now  stands  it  is  evident  that  the  service  is 
left  to  the  discretion  of  the  minister,  so  long 
as  he  uses  the  words  of  our  Lord,  together 
with  the  pouring  of  water  in  the  name  of 
the   Trinity. — Hook's  Archbishops,  i.  443  ; 


616 


PEIVy  COUNCIL 


Walcott's  Sac.  Arch.  p.  472  (See  Baptism, 
Lay  Baptism).     [H.] 

PRIVY  COUNCIL  JUDGMENTS 
(See  Delegates).  A  collection  of  the  eccle- 
siastical judgments  of  the  Privy  Council,  with 
a  preface  by  Archbishop  Tait,  was  published 
by  Brodrick  and  Fremantle  in  1865.    [H.] 

PROCESSION  OP  THE  HOLY 
GHOST.  As  the  Father  is  eternal,  with- 
out beginning,  so  is  the  Son  without  begin- 
ning, the  only  begotten,  God  of  God,  Light 
of  fight,  being  very  God  of  very  God :  in 
like  manner  the  Holy  Ghost,  without  be- 
gining,  has  proceeded  from  the  Father  and 
the  Son.  This  is  one  of  the  mysteries  which 
must  be  always  incomprehensible,  from  our 
inability  to  comprehend  an  eternity  a  parte 
ante.  In  all  discussions  relating  to  these 
subjects,  we  may  quote  to  the  objector  the 
wise  words  of  Gregory  Nazianzen :  "  Do  you 
tell  me  how  the  Father  is  unbegotten,  and 
I  will  then  attempt  to  tell  you  how  the 
Son  is  begotten  and  the  Spirit  proceeds." 

We  will  first  give  the  doctrine  as  stated 
in  the  Articles  and  Creed,  and  then  give 
from  Dr.  Hey  the  history  of  the  controversy 
which  has  long  subsisted  between  the  East- 
ern and  the  Western  Church. 

Of  the  Holy  Ghost  the  fifth  article  says, 
"The  Holy  Ghost,  proceeding  from  the 
Father  and  the  Son,  is  of  one  substance, 
majesty,  and  glory,  with  the  Father  and  the 
Son,  very  and  eternal  God." 

The  same  doctrine  is  declared  in  the 
Nicene  and  Athanasian  Creeds. 

In  the  Nicene  Creed : 

"  I  believe  in  the  Holy  Ghost,  who  pro- 
ceedeth  from  the  Father  and  the  Son." 

In  the  Athanasian  Creed : 

"  The  Holy  Ghost  is  of  the  Father  and  of 
the  Son,  neither  made  nor  created  nor  be- 
gotten, but  proceeding." 

In  the  fourth,  fifth,  and  sixth  centuries, 
various  disputes  took  place  with  the  fol- 
lowers of  Macedonius  with  respect  to  the 
nature  and  procession  of  the  Holy  Ghost. 
It  may  be  particularly  mentioned,  with  a 
view  to  what  followed,  that  so  soon  as  the 
years  430  and  431,  in  the  Councils  of  Alex- 
andria and  Ephesus,  it  was  declared  that 
the  Holy  Ghost  prooeedeth  from  the  Son  as 
well  as  from  the  Father.  In  order  to  termi- 
nate these  disputes,  the  Church  in  general 
made  a  sort  of  settlement  or  detei-mination 
what  should  be  accounted  Catholic  doctrine ; 
and,  to  avoid  further  adjustings  of  formu- 
laries, agreed  that  nothing  should  from  that 
time  be  added  to  those  then  under  consider- 
ation. It  is  probable  that,  at  that  time,  the 
question  whether  the  Holy  Ghost  should  be 
spoken  of  as  proceeding  from  the  Father 
and  the  Son  {Filioque  is  the  famous  word) 
did  not  occur  to  men's  minds.  Filioque 
was  not  in  the  creeds,  though  it  was  not 


PROCESSION 

new.  The  students  in  the  Western  Church 
seem  ere  long  to  have  contracted  an  opinion, 
that  it  was  proper  for  them  to  profess  in  a 
creed,  that  the  Holy  Ghost  proceedeth  from 
the  Son ;  they,  therefore,  inserted  (or,  one 
might  say,  restored)  Filioque  at  the  Council 
of  Toledo  (a.d.  589);  and  the  Eastern 
Church  thought  as  little  of  complaining  as 
the  Western  of  offending.  Afterwards,  how- 
ever, contentions  for  worldly  grandeur  pro- 
duced contentions  about  theological  truth. 
Rome  and  Constantinople  were  rivals,  not 
only  for  imperial  but  for  spiritual  pre- 
eminence. The  patriarch  of  Constantinople 
styled  himself  Episcopus  (Eciimenicus. 
Gregory  the  Great,  bishop  of  Rome,  was 
more  lowly  in  the  title  he  assumed  ;  he  was 
"  servus  servorum  "  scilicet  Dei ;  but  in  his 
pretensions  to  authority  he  was  equally  am- 
bitious. The  patriarch  was  at  the  head  of 
the  Eastern  Church,  the  pope  of  the  West- 
ern. This  rivalship  made  the  Churches 
seek  occasions  for  blaming  each  other,  and 
thus  the  insertion  of  Filioque  came  to  be 
complained  of  as  a  breach  of  faith.  It  was 
defended  by  the  Western  Church,  because 
the  word  contained  right  doctrine :  this  was 
enough  to  make  the  Eastern  Church  dispute, 
the  doctrine:  they  did  so,  and  the  dispute 
still  subsists,  and  still  causes  a  separation 
between  the  Eastern  and  Western  Churches. 
One  pope  (Leo  III.,  a.d.  809)  did  once,  for 
the  sake  of  peace,  order  Filioque  to  be  put 
out  of  the  creed,  at  the  same  time  ratifying 
the  doctrine  which  it  comprehends;  but  he 
could  only  prevail  in  those  churches  which 
were  under  his  immediate  sanction,  and  that 
only  for  a  time.  The  obstinate  resistance 
of  the  Greek  or  Eastern  Church  to  the  in- 
sertion of  Filioque  is  the  more  hkely  to  be 
owing  to  some  worldly  consideration,  as 
several  of  the  Greek  Fathers  have  the  doc- 
trine in  their  works  clearly  expressed. 
Among  the  most  important  passages  of  Holy 
Scripture  bearing  on  the  subject  may  be 
mentioned  Rom.  viii.  9 ;  1  St.  Pet.  i.  11- 
GaL  iv.  6  ;  St.  John  xv.  26  (See  Holy 
Qhost;  Filioque;   Creed). 

PROCESSION  (procedere):  a  goino. 
forth,  used  in  the  first  instance  generally  for 
going  to  any  meeting,  and  then  especially 
for  going  to  a  religious  service.  In  the 
latter  sense  Tertullian  uses  it,  speakino- 
of  a  modest  "going  to  church"  (processiS) 
and  an  united  congregation  (Be  Brmsent 
Sair.  43).  Public  processions  seem  to  have 
been  in  vogue  in  the  time  of  St.  Basil,  and 
of  St.  Ambrose,  the  latter  speaking  of 
psalms  being  sung  by  the  priests  as  they 
went  to  the  celebration  of  a  feast  (Bas. 
Epist.  207,  ad  Neoc. :  Ambr.  Epist ;  40,  ad 
Theodos.).  But  the  most  celebrated  were 
those  begun  at  Constantinople  by  St.  Chry- 
sostom.     The    Arians   of  that    city    beino- 


PKOCESSION 

forced  to  hold  their  meetings  without  the 
town,'went  thither  night  and  morning,  sing- 
ing anthems.  Chrysostom,  to  prevent  their 
perverting  the  Catiiolics,  sot  up  counter- 
processions,  in  which  the  clergy  and  people 
marched  by  night,  singing  prayers  and 
hymns,  and  carrying  crosses  and  flambeaux 
(Sozom.  E.  E.  viii.  8  ;  Stephens'  Life  of  St. 
John  Chrysostom,  p.  236).  It  was  forbidden 
that  processions  should  be  celebrated  with- 
out the  clergy  (Justin.  Novell.  123).  Prom 
this  period,  the  custom  of  processions  was 
introduced  among  the  Greeks,  and  after- 
wards among  the  Latins;  but  they  have 
subsisted  longer,  and  been  more  frequently 
used,  in  the  Western  than  in  the  Eastern 
Church.  On  special  occasions  they  were 
carried  out  with  great  pomp  and  solemnity, 
as  in  the  case  of  laying  the  first  stone  of  a 
church,  or  at  the  dedication  of  a  church 
(Justin.  Novell.  67).  There  were  in  the 
early  and  middle  ages  processions  before  the 
service,  before  the  reading  of  the  gospel, 
after  the  reading  of  the  gospel,  and  at  the 
end  of  the  service  (Ordo  liomanus,  i.  8  : 
in  Mus.  Ital.  ii.  8:  i.  21:  ii.  15,  &c.). 
But  there  was  of  course  much  variation  in 
different  places.  The  usual  order  in  cathe- 
drals was  first  the  verger,  then  the  cross- 
bearer,  attended  on  either  side  by  acolyths 
carrying  candlesticks  and  lighted  tapers; 
then  the  thurifers,  or  censer-bearers,  the 
chanters,  or  priest  vicars  in  copes,  the  sub- 
deacon,  deacon  and  celebrant,  the  choir 
boys  and  lay  vicars,  or  clerks  of  the  second 
grade,  the  precentor,  the  subchanter  (pre- 
diantre),  the  succentor  of  vicars  (^sous- 
chantre),  and  last  the  bishop  with  his  staff 
borne  before  him.  Processions  were  made 
with  litanies  and  prayers  (see  Litany ;  Itogar 
tion  Days),  (L)  for  the  prosperity  of  the 
sovereign ;  (ii.)  the  welfare  of  the  nation ; 
(iii).  pureness  of  air,  and  relief  from  disease ; 
(iv.)  the  increase  of  the  fruits  of  the  earth. 
Arrangements  were  made  for  particular 
processions  in  cathedrals  and  abbeys.  At 
Canterbury  there  were  two  parallel  Hnes,  and 
at  Fountains,  Lincoln,  Chichester,  and  York 
two  rows  of  circular  processional  stones 
placed  at  proper  intervals,  to  shew  where 
the  procession  was  to  be  arranged.  On  Ash- 
Wednesday,  Palm  Sunday,  and  Easter-day 
there  were  special  processions.  At  Durham 
"  upon  Sancte  Mark's  dale,  after  Easter,  the 
prior  with  the  monncks  had  a  solemne  pro- 
cession, and  went  to  the  Bowe  church  with 
their  procession"  (Rites  of  tJie  Church  of 
,  Durham,  p.  87).  Similar  customs  on 
certain  days  are  mentioned  by  different 
county  historians  ;  as  for  instance,  at  Kin- 
t-jnersley,  and  Wellington,  where  on  Easter 
fe-Monday  the  parishioners,  joining  hand  in 
^hand,  surrovmded  the  church,  and  touched 
^*;it ^together  —  which  was  called   "clipping 


PEOOESSIONALE 


617 


the  church."  At  AVolverhampton  the  prac- 
tice of  walking  in  procession  on  rogation 
days,  the  children  bearing  poles  dressed 
with  flowers,  and  the  clergy  chanting  the 
Benedicite,  only  ceased  in  1765,  and  in 
sundry  other  places  has  not  ceased  yet, 
except  as  to  the  chanting.  Superstitious 
usages  sprang  up  in  connexion  with  pro- 
cessions, such  as  carrying  about  relics  or 
the  consecrated  elements  for  the  people  to 
adore  (see  Article  xxv.),  which  still  arc 
observed  in  foreign  countries. — Bingham, 
xiii. ;  Maskell,  Mon.  Hit.  i.  cxxvi. :  ii. 
322;  Walcott's  Sac.  Arch.  p.  475;  Diet. 
Christ.  Ant.  1716.     [H.] 

PROCESSIONAL  CROSSES :  used  pro- 
bably as  early  as  the  4th  century.  They 
are  mentioned  by  Durand  in  the  Life  of  St. 
Porphyry,  and  by  Baronius  under  the  year 
401.  The  empress  Eudoxia  supplied  the 
church  with  silver  crosses  which  were 
carried  before  the  people  (Soc.  H.  E.  vi.  c. 
8  ;  Soz.  viii.  c.  8).  By  the  laws  of  Justi- 
nian it  was  expressly  provided  that  such 
crosses  should  not  be  kept  in  any  place  but 
the  church,  and  that  only  those  persons 
properly  appointed  should  carry  them 
(Justin.  Novell.  123).  In  England  orders 
were  given  with  regard  to  their  use  at  the 
Council  of  Clovesho  in  747.  The  custom 
appears  to  have  been  to  carry  a  cross  of 
wood  painted  red  in  Lent,  of  crystal  or 
beryl  at  other  times.  At  Durham  the  chief 
cross  was  of  gold  with  a  silver  staff,  and 
that  used  on  ordinary  days  of  crystal.  At 
Chichester  the  aumbry,  or  closet,  for  the 
crosses  still  remains.  ISIo  doubt  many  pro- 
cessional crosses  were  destroyed  or  got  rid  of 
at  the  dissolution  of  the  monasteries,  in  the 
course  of  the  Reformation,  and  during  the 
Rebellion.  What  was  probably  the  pro- 
cessional cross  of  the  Cistercian  Abbey  of 
Old  Cleeve,  Somerset,  was  found  in  a  farm- 
house in  1878.  It  is  of  brass  with  a 
very  small  figure  of  our  Lord  upon  it; 
and  it  had  been  evidently  richly  jewelled. 
It  is  of  a  well-known  type ;  there  are  three 
or  four  of  them  at  South  Kensington, 
and  one  at  least  at  the  British  Museum. 
They  are  typical  English  work  of  about 
the  middle  of  the  15th  century,  such  as 
doubtless  every  parish  church  possessed. 
They  are  interesting  because  of  the  rarity 
of  English  pre-Eeibrmation  ecclesiastical 
ornaments.  "  In  processions,"  said  Cran- 
mer,  "  we  follow  the  cross  of  our  Saviour, 
professing  ourselves,  as  true  Christian  i^eople, 
ready  to  bear  our  cross  with  Christ, 
willingly  to  suffer  all  troubles  and  afflictions 
laid  upon  us  for  the  love  and  cause  of  our 
Saviour,  as  He  suffered  for  us." — Palmer's 
Orig.  Liturg.  i.  265  ;  Walcott's  Sac.  Arch. 
476  ;  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.     [H.] 

PROCESSIONALE :  a  book  containing 


618 


PEOCTOE 


oiiices  and  directions  for  litanies  and  pro- 
cessions (Ducange,  Gloss.).  It  was  a  well- 
known  book,  and  we  find  it  often  in  tlie 
old  inventories  (see  for  account  Maskell, 
Mon.  Bit  i.  cxxiii.).     [H.] 

PROCTOE  (Lat.,  Procurator).  I.  Proc- 
tors are  officers  established  to  represent,  in 
judicial  proceedings,  the  parties  who  em- 
power them  (by  warrant  under  their  hands, 
called  a,  proxy)  to  appear  for  them  to  ex- 
plain their  rights,  to  manage  their  cause, 
and  to  demand  judgment  (See  Ducange, 
Gloss.).  The  holding  of  the  office  of  "  pro- 
curator "  by  the  clergy  was  much  discouraged 
in  the  early  times.  St.  Augustine  wrote 
against  it  {De  Op.  Monarch,  c.  15),  and 
St.  Jerome  asks  how  the  clergy,  who  are 
supposed  to  have  renounced  all  care  for 
their  temporal  possessions,  can  vmdertake  to 
be  procurators  and  dispensers  of  the  estates 
of  otheis  (Ep.  ad  Nepot.  c.  16).  Several 
councils  also  prohibited  the  clergy  from 
taking  part  in  secular  matters,  as  the  first 
council  of  Carthage,  a.d.  348  (cc.  8, 9) ;  the 
third  of  the  same  place  which  prohibited  any 
clergy  from  being  "  procuratores,"  or  being 
entangled  in  any  secular  affairs  (c.  15)  ; 
the  Council  of  Chaloedon,  a.d.  451  (c.  3), 
which  laid  down  the  same  rule,  with  the 
exception,  however,  of  any  business  imposed 
upon  the  clergy  by  law,  or  given  to  them 
by  the  bishop,  or  on  behalf  of  widows  and 
orphans.  Later  councils,  however,  allowed 
the  clergy  to  act  as  proctors  or  advocates  in 
certain  cases.  In  England,  from  the  Con- 
quest till  the  15th  century  the  great  majority 
of  lawyers  or  proctors  in  all  the  courts  of 
justice  were  in  holy  orders  (Hook's  Arch- 
bishops, V.  173). 

II.  The  representatives  of  the  clergy  in 
convocation  are  also  called  proctors.  Deans 
and  archdeacons  are  "  ex  officio  "  members ; 
besides  them  two  proctors  are  appointed 
from  each  diocese  by  the  votes  of  the  clergy 
(See  Official  Tear-book  of  the  Church  of 
England,  188G,  p.  288  :  Convocation). 

III.  The  same  name  is  given  to  university 
officers,  whose  business  is  to  guard  the 
morals  and  preserve  the  quiet  of  the  uni- 
versity at  Oxford  and  Cambridge ;  to  pre- 
sent candidates  in  arts  and  music  for  their 
degrees ;  and  (formerly  in  a  more  special 
manner  than  at  present)  to  superintend 
their  public  exercises.  The  latter  is  now 
the  prominent  practice  of  the  proctors  in 
the  University  of  Dublin :  the  senior  proc- 
tor presiding  at  the  Master's  exercises,  the 
junior  at  the  Bachelors'.  They  are  two  in 
number,  and  chosen  annually  by  the  several 
colleges  in  cycle. 

IV.  Procurators  were  officers  in  some  of 
the  ancient  imiversities  of  Europe,  as  in 
Paris;  they  were  then  four  in  number, 
elected   annually,  each  by  one  of  the  four 


PEOFESSOK 

nations  into  which  the  students  were  divided ; 
and  the  rector,  the  deans  of  divinity,  law, 
medicine,  and  the  four  proctors,  formed  the 
standing  council  of  the  imiversity :  some- 
what analogous  to  the  caput  at  Cambridge. 
The  deans  were  the  proctors  of  their 
respective  faculties.  Anciently  the  Uni- 
versity of  Oxford  was  divided  into  two 
"  nations,"  as  they  might  be  called,  each  of 
which  was  represented  by  a  proctor.    [H.] 

PEOCUEATION.  A  pecuniary  sum  or 
composition  by  an  incumbent  to  an  ordin- 
ary or  other  ecclesiastical  judge,  to  commute 
for  the  provision,  or  entertainment,  which 
he  was  formerly  expected  to  provide  for 
such  ordinary  at  the  time  of  visitation.  (See 
Synodal.) 

PEOPESSION  OP  FAITH  (I.)  made 
at  baptism.  The  minister  asks,  "Dost 
thou  believe  in  God  the  Father,"  &c.,  re- 
hearsing the  articles  of  belief;  and  the 
answer  is  required,  "  All  this  I  stedfastly 
believe."  'i  hough  the  Creed  was  not  com- 
mitted to  writing  in  his  time,  TertuUian 
refers  to  the  profession  (de  Coron.  iii.),  and 
the  profession  of  Palmatius,  wlio  was  baptized 
about  A.D.  220,  is  extant : — "  Credis,  in  toto 
corde,  in  Deum  Patrem  Omnipotentem,  Fac- 
torem  omnium  visibilium  et  invisibilium? 
Bespondit  Palmatius.  Credo.  Et  in  Jesum 
Christum  Filium  ejus  ?  et  ait.  Credo,"  and  so 
ontill"et carnisresurrectionem?  Exclamavit 
cumlacrymis  Palmatius  :  Credo  "  (Heurtley's 
Harmonia  Symbolica,  p.  106).  St.  Cyril 
says  that  this  profession  of  faith  was  made 
towards  the  East  (Catcch.  Lect.  xix.  9).  In 
the  Gelasian  Sacramentary,  in  the  Salisbury 
Use,  and  the  first  English  book,  there  wwe 
three  several  questions  on  the  Creed;  which 
were  put  together  in  the  Prayer  Book  of  1552 
(Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  ii.  222  ;  Mozley,  On 
Baptism). 

H.  In  the  Office  for  the  Visitation  of  the 
Sick,  a  profession  of  faith  is  asked  from  the 
sick  person.  In  the  ancient  English  office 
many  questions  were  asked.  Mr.  Maskell 
gives  a  form  of  examination  from  a  MS. 
(No.  117,  fol.  1236)  in  the  library  of  St. 
John's  College,  Oxford,  and  with  this  may 
be  compared  others,  for  instance  Harleiau 
MS.  211,  237  {Mon.  Bit.  Eccl.  Ang.  iii. 
414).  The  form  prescribed  in  the  Church 
of  England  is  simple,  being  based  solely  on 
the  Creed. 

PKOFESSOE.  I.  One  who  makes  open 
declaration  of  his  feehngs  or  opinions ;  par- 
ticularly, one  who  makes  a  public  avowal 
of  his  behef  in  the  Scriptures  and  his  faith 
in  Christ,  and  thus  unites  himself  to  the 
visible  Church. 

II.  One  that  jjublicly  teaches  any  science 
or  branch  of  learning  in  an  university,  college 
or  seminary  under  a  royal  charter,  whose 
business  is  to  read  lectures  or  to  instruct 


PKOPHECY 

students  in  a  particular  branch  of  learning ; 
as  a  professor  of  Theolosy,  or  Matliematics, 
&c.    [H.] 

PIWPER  LESSONS  (See  Lessmis;  Lec- 
tionary).  In  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549,  when 
the  revised  system  of  daily  and  proper 
lessons  was  established,  there  were  no  proper 
lessons  assigned  for  ordinary  Sundays,  the 
books  of  Holy  Scripture  being  read  continu- 
ously as  on  week-days.  At  the  restoration 
of  the  use  of  the  Prayer  Book  in  1559  the 
Tables  of  Proper  Lessons  were  introduced, 
and  they  were  altered  into  their  present  form 
in  1870.  All  the  changes  in  1661  were 
written  in  the  margin  of  Bishop  Cosin's 
Durham  Prayer  Book.    [H.] 

PKOPER  PSALMS.  The  use  of  these 
is  of  great  antiquity.  St.  Augustine  says 
that  Ps.  xxii.  was  always  read  on  Good 
Friday  in  the  African  Church.  There  were, 
however,  no  proper  psalms  assigned  for 
Good  Friday  or  Ash-Wednesday  in  the 
Prayer  Book  of  1549,  but  only  for  the  four 
great  festivals.  The  others  were  added  in 
1661.     [H.] 

PROPHECY  (7rpo(j>r,T€ia)  :  literaUy  a 
speaking  for  God.  The  declaration  of  a 
divine  message ;  and  so  secondarily  the  power 
of  foretelling  (see  Scripture,  Inspiration  of; 
Miracles).  As  the  divine  message  often  re- 
lated i  to  future  events,  the  word  came  to  be 
commonly  used  as  equivalent  to  prediction, 
but  this  meaning  is  not  necessarily  involved 
in  the  word  itself  (1  Tim.  i.  18:  iv.l4).  The 
lesson  which  is  now  ordinarily  designated 
the  "  Epistle,"  was  in  early  times  often 
called  the  "Apostle"  or  the  "Prophecy," 
because  the  words  were  taken  either  from 
the  Apostolic  writings,  or  the  prophets 
(TertuU.  de  Friescr.  Hser.  c.  36;  Menard. 
Sacram.  Oregorii,  p.  2 ;  Lit.  Clirysos.  Goar, 
p.  68).  The  lections  from  the  prophetical 
■writings  read  and  sung  by  the  deacon 
and  choir  on  Easter  Eve,  which  was  a  relic 
of  Scriptural  instruction  given  to  catechu- 
mens on  the  day  in  the  early  Church, 
were  called  "prophecies." — Palmer,  Orig. 
Liturg.  iL  42.     [H.] 

PROPHESYINGS.  ReUgious  exercises  of 
certain  of  the  clergy  in  the  reign  of  Queen 
Elizabeth,  instituted  for  the  purpose  of 
promoting  knowledge  and  piety.  The 
ministers  of  a  particular  division  at  a  set 
time  met  together  in  some  church  of  a 
market  or  other  large  town,  and  there  each 
in  order  explained,  according  totheir  abilities 
or  ideas,  some  portion  of  Scripture  allotted 
to  them  before.  This  done,  a  moderator 
made  his  observations  on  what  head  been 
said,  and  detennined  the  true  sense  of  the 
place,  a  certain  space  of  time  being  fixed  for 
despatching  the  whole.  Whatever  may  be 
thought  of  the  proceeding  itself,  it  was  ill 
adapted  for  the  time.    Controversial  subjects 


PEGPITIATION 


619' 


were  continually  introduced,  disputations 
on  various  matters  took  place,  the  authority 
of  the  Church,  the  lawfulness  of  Episcopacy 
was  called  in  question,  and  division  wa& 
protracted.  The  queen  desired  the  arch- 
bishop, Parker,  to  suppress  the  meetings,, 
which  he  endeavoured  to  do.  But  they 
continued,  and  Grindal  afterwards  refused 
to  suppress  them,  as  he  thought  the  evils- 
might  be  corrected,  and  the  abuses  guarded 
against.  He  besought  the  queen  to  refer 
"  all  these  ecclesiastical  matters  which  touch 
religion,  or  the  doctrine  and  discipline  of  the 
Church,  unto  the  bishops  and  divines  of 
your  realm,  according  to  the  example  of  all 
godly  Christian  emperors  and  princes  of  all 
ages."  Prophesyings  were  forbidden  by  the 
72nd  canon  of  1603  (See  Hook's  Arch- 
hishops,  ix.  411 :  x.  94).     [H.] 

PKOPHET  (7rpd^7)p)  :  strictly  one  wh» 
speaks  for  another,  especially  in  heathen, 
writers ;  one  who  speaks  for  a  God,  and 
interprets  His  will  to  man  whether  it  relates 
to  the  present  or  the  future  (Pind.  N.  1,  91 ; 
.iEsch.  Eum.  19,  &c.).  In  this  sense  it  is- 
used  in  the  Scriptures,  the  "  schools  of  the 
prophets"  being  places  where  persons  were 
trained  in  the  interpretation  of  the  law  of 
God ;  and  in  the  same  way  St.  Paul  uses  it 
(Eph.  iv.  11). 

Our  idea  of  a  seer,  or  one  who  foretells- 
future  events,  is  a  secondary  meaning  of  the 
word.  The  original  idea  is  rather  that 
of  a  forihteWer  than  a  /oreteller.  We 
have  in  the  Old  Testament  the  writings 
of  sixteen  prophets ;  that  is,  of  four 
greater  prophets,  and  twelve  lesser  pro- 
phets. The  four  greater  prophets  are, 
Isaiah,  Jeremiah,  Ezekiel,  and  Daniel.  The 
Jews  do  not  place  Daniel  among  the  pro- 
phets, because  (they  say)  he  lived  in  the 
splendour  of  temporal  dignities,  and  a  kind 
of  life  different  from  other  prophets.  The 
twelve  lesser  prophets  are,  Hosea,  Joel, 
Amos,  Obadiah,  Micah,  Jonah,  Nahum, 
Habakkuk,  Zephaniah,  Haggai,  Zechariah, 
and  Malachi.     [H.] 

PROPITIATION  (See  Covenant  of 
Bedemption,  Sacrifice,  Atonement,  Satis- 
faction, Jesus).  Propitiation  is  originally 
a  Latin  word,  and  signifies  the  appeasing  of 
the  wrath  of  God,  or  doing  something 
whereby  He  may  be  rendered  propitious,, 
kind,  or  merciful,  to  us,  notwithstanding: 
that  we  have  provoked  Him  to  anger  by  any 
sin  or  offence  committed  against  Him.  The 
Greek  word  iXao-^or  is  plainly  used  by  the 
LXX.  for  the  Hebrew  DKian  (Ezek.  xliv.  27),. 
and  as  a  propitiatory  sacrifice,  referring  to  om- 
Blessed  Lord,  it  is  used  by  St.  John  (1  St_ 
John  ii.  2  :  iv.  10).  The  word  evidently 
implies  a  sacrifice  or  offering  made  to  God 
for  the  sins  of  men,  which  He  is  pleasedi 
to  accept   as   a   sufficient   atonement   and. 


€20 


PEOPKOCTOES 


satisfaction  for  the  dishonour  and  injury 
that  was  done  Him  by  them,  so  as  not  to 
require  the  punishments  which  were  due, 
but  to  forgive  them  all,  and  to  become  again 
■as  kind  and  propitious  to  the  persons  that 
offended  Him  as  if  He  had  never  been  of- 
fended by  them.  This  offering  is  Christ 
HimseK,  Who  is  "  the  propitiation  for  our 
sins." 

PROPROCTOBS.  Two  assistants  of 
the  proctors  in  the  universities  nominated 
by  them. 

PROSA.  In  singing  the  AUeluia  after 
the  Epistle,  a  custom  which  is  said  by 
Gregory  the  Great  to  have  been  introduced 
by  Damasus  (Greg.  Mag.  Epist.  ad  Johan. 
Syracus.  lib.  x.  Epist.  12),  it  became  a 
common  use  to  prolong  the  last  syllable 
upon  a  number  of  notes.  Words  in  rhyth- 
mical prose  were  afterwards  arranged  to 
these  notes,  and  later  metrical  hymns,  and 
these  were  called  jarosss.  In  the  eighth 
century,  Notker,  abbot  of  St.  Gall,  in 
Switzerland,  composed  several  of  these 
jorosss,  otherwise  called  sequentix,  which 
were  sung  after  the  Gradual  (Bona,  Ber. 
Liturg.  lib.  ii.  c.  6).  Pope  Nicolas  I.  first 
authorised  their  use.  They  soon  became 
very  numerous,  and  often  very  ridiculous, 
and  were  retrenched  by  the  Council  of 
Cologne  in  1536,  and  of  Reims  in  1564. 
The  "  Veni  Creator  Spiritus,"  appointed  by 
Pope  Innocent  for  Whitsuntide ;  "  Lauda 
Sion  Salvatorem,'.  wi'itten  either  by  Bona- 
ventura  or  St.  T.  Aquinas ;  "  Dies  Iras,  dies 
ilia;"  and  the  "Stabat  Mater,"  said  to  be 
the  composition  of  Innocent  III.,  are  the 
best  known  prosa3.  The  prosse  were  used 
in  England  before  the  Reformation  (Jdiss. 
Sar.  fol.  11, 12,  &c.),  but  in  consequence  of 
erroneous  ideas  contained  in  most  of  them, 
they  were  altogether  omitted  by  the  revisers 
of  our  Liturgy. — Palmer,  Orig.  Liturg.  ii. 
49  ;  Burney's  Hist.  Music ;  Diet.  Clirist. 
Antiq.     [H.] 

PROSTRATION  (See  Genuflexion). 

PROTESTANT.  The  designation  of 
Frolestant  is  used  in  England  as  a  general 
term  to  denote  all  who  protest  against 
Popery.  Such,  however,  was  neither  the 
original  acceptation  of  the  word,  nor  is  it 
the  sense  in  which  it  is  still  applied  on  the 
Continent.  It  was  originally  given  to  those 
who  protested  against  a  certain  decree 
issued  by  the  emperor  Charles  V.  and  the 
Diet  of  Spires  in  1529. — Stubbs'  Mosheim, 
fdi.  126. 

On  the  Continent  it  is  applied  as  a  term 
to  distinguish  the  Lutheran  communions. 
The  Lutherans  are  called  Protestants ;  the 
<CaIvinists,  the  Reformed.  The  use  of  the 
word  among  ourselves  in  a  sense  different 
from  that  adopted  by  our  neighbours 
abroad,  has  sometimes  led  to  curious  mis- 


PEOTESTANT 

takes.  The  late  Mr.  Canning,  for  instance, 
in  his  zeal  to  support  the  Romanists,  and 
not  being  sufBciently  well  instructed  in 
the  principles  of  the  Church  of  England, 
assumed  it  as  if  it  were  an  indisputable 
fact,  that,  being  Protestants,  we  must  hold 
the  doctrine  of  consubstantiation.  Having 
consulted,  probably,  some  foreign  history 
of  Protestantism,  he  found  that  one  of  the 
tenets  which  distinguishes  the  "  Protestant," 
i.e.  the  Lutheran,  from  the  "Reformed," 
i.e.  the  CalvinL<;t,  is  that  the  former  main- 
tains, the  latter  denies,  the  dogma  of  con- 
substantiation. 

It  is  evident  that  in  our  application  of  the 
word  it  is  a  mere  term  of  negation.  If  a 
man  says  that  he  is  a  Protestant,  he  only 
teUs  us  that  he  is  not  a  Romanist ;  at  the 
same  time  he  may  be — what  is  worse — a 
Socinian,  or  even  an  infidel,  for  these  are  all 
united  under  the  common  principle  of  pro- 
testing against  Popery.  But  the  word  is 
universally  understood  to  mean  a  Christian 
of  some  kind.  The  appellation  is  not 
given  to  us,  as  far  as  the  writer  knows, 
in  any  of  our  formularies,  and  has  chiefly 
been  employed  in  political  warfare  as  a 
watchword  to  rally  in  one  band  all  who, 
whatever  may  be  their  religious  differences, 
are  prepared  to  act  politically  against  the 
aggressions  of  the  Romanists.  In  this 
respect  it  was  particularly  useful  at  the 
time  of  the  Revolution;  and,  as  politics 
intrude  themselves  into  all  the  considera- 
tions of  an  Englishman,  either  directly  or 
indirectly,  the  term  is  endeared  to  a  power- 
ful and  influential  party  in  the  State.  But 
on  the  very  ground  that  it  thus  keeps  out 
of  view  distinguishing  and  vital  principles, 
and  unites  in  apparent  agreement  those 
who  essentially  differ,  many  of  our  divines 
object  to  the  use  of  the  word.  They  con- 
tend, with  good  reason,  that  it  is  quite 
absurd  to  speak  of  the  Protestant  religion, 
since  a  religion  must,  of  course,  be  dis- 
tinguished, not  by  what  it  renounces,  but 
by  what  it  professes :  they  apprehend  that 
it  has  occasioned  a  kind  of  sceptical  habit 
of  inquiring,  not  how  much  we  ought  to 
believe,  but  how  much  we  may  refuse  to 
believe;  of  looking  at  what  is  negative 
instead  of  what  is  positive  in  our  religion ; 
of  fearing  to  inquire  after  the  truth,  lest  it 
should  lead  to  something  which  is  held  by 
the  Papists  in  common  with  ourselves,  and 
which,  therefore,  as  some  persons  seem  to 
argue,  no  sound  Protestant  can  hold ;  for- 
getting that  on  this  principle  we  ought  to 
renounce  the  liturgy,  the  sacraments,  the 
doctrine  of  the  Trinity,  the  Divinity  and 
atonement  of  Christ — nay,  the  very  Bible 
itself.  It  is  on  these  grounds  that  some 
writers  have  scrupled  to  use  the  word  ;  but 
although  it  is  certainly  absurd  to  speak  of 


PEOTHESIS 

the  Protestant  religion,  i.e.  a  negative  re- 
ligion, yet  thoro  is  no  aljsurdity  in  speaking 
of  the  Church  of  England  or  of  the  Church 
of  America  as  a  Protestant  Glmrch;  the 
word  Church  conveys  a  positive  idea,  and 
there  can  bo  no  reason  why  we  should  not 
have  also  a  negative  appellation.  If  we  admit 
that  the  Cliurch  of  Rome  is  a  true,  though,  as 
we  think,  a  corrupt -Church,  it  is  well  to  have 
a  term  hy  which  we  may  alwaj's  declare 
that,  while  we  hold  in  common  with  her  aU 
that  she  has  which  is  Catholic,  scriptural, 
and  pure,  we  protest  for  ever  against  her 
multiplied  corruptions.  Besides,  the  word, 
whether  correctly  or  not,  is  in  general  use, 
and  is  in  a  certain  sense  applicable  to  the 
Church  of  England.  It  is  surely  therefore 
better  to  retain  it,  only  with  this  under- 
standing, that,  when  we  call  ourselves 
Protestants,  we  mean  no  more  to  profess 
that  we  hold  communion  with  all  parties 
who  are  so  styled,  than  the  Church  of  Eng- 
land, when,  in  her  creeds  and  formularies, 
she  designates  herself,  not  as  the  Protestant, 
but  as  the  Catliolic  Church  of  this  country, 
intends  to  hold  communion  with  those 
Catholic  Churches  abroad  which  have  in- 
fused into  their  system  the  principles  of  the 
Council  of  Trent.  Protestant  is  our  nega- 
tive, Catholic  our  definitive  name.  We  tell 
the  Papist  that,  with  respect  to  him,  we 
are  Protestant ;  we  tell  the  Protestant 
Dissenter  that,  with  respect  to  him,  we  are 
Catholic ;  and  we  may  be  called  Protestant 
or  Protesting  Catholics,  or,  as  some  of  our 
writers  describe  us,  Anglo-Catholics  (See 
Hook's  Archbishops,  vi.  27 :  ix.  61,  265, 
note). 

PEOTHESIS.  The  place  in  a  church 
on  which  the  elements  in  the  Eucharist 
are  jilaoed,  previously  to  their  being  laid 
as  an  oblation  on  the  altar.  Called  also 
credence  (q.  v.).  The  word  prothesis  (wpo6i(TLs) 
is  derived  from  the  temple  service,  in  which 
the  placing  of  the  shewbread  was  called 
T]  TTpodea-K  Tav  aprav,  and  the  bread  itself, 
ot  aproL  TTjs  irpoQea-^ais,  i.e.  the  loaves  set 
in  order  before  the  Lord.  The  prothesis  or 
credence  table  is  placed  at  the  north  or  left 
side  of  the  altar  as  one  faces  it  (which  is 
sometimes  called  the  "right"  side,  being 
at  the  priest's  right  hand),  and  on  it  the 
priest  arranges  and  prepares  what  is  ne- 
cessary for  the  service  of  the  altar  (Suicer, 
Thesaurus,  p.  842).  That  this  was  its 
position  in  the  early  times,  most  writers 
agree,  though  some  hold  a  different  opinion, 
as  Renaudot  (Lit.  Orient,  i.  188,  Paris  ed.). 
Perhaps  it  differed  in  different  churches. 
On  this  see  Bingham,  Antiq.  viii.,  vi.  22 ; 
Beveridge,  Annot.  in  Can.  Cone.  Nic. ;  Diet. 
Clirist.  Antiq.  1740. 

PROTHONOTARY  :  lit.  the  first  of  the 
notaries  or  scribes.     This  hybrid  word  had 


PROVERBS 


621 


a  different  signification  in  the  Greek  Church 
from  what  it  had  in  the  Latin.  The  officer 
is  mentioned  by  Socrates  as  nparoa-TaTris: 
Tav  ^acriXiKuv  v7roypa<p(o>v  {II.  E.  vii.  23). 
Afterwards  his  office  was  enlarged.  He 
became  very  important :  was  empowered' 
to  have  an  inspection  over  the  professors  of 
the  law,  into  purchases,  wills,  and  the 
liberty  given  to  slaves  :  read  the  gospel  on 
Palm  Sunday :  took  precedence  of  the  five 
great  dignitaries  of  the  Greel;:  Church 
(Exocatacoeli),  ranking  thus  next  to  the 
patriarch  (Goar,  Eucliol.  .1?>2,  270,  276,. 
277).  In  the  Latin  Church  those  were  for- 
merly called  prothonotaries  who  had  the 
especial  charge  of  writing  the  acts  of  the 
martyrs,  and  the  circumstances  of  theii- 
deaths.  It  was  applied  by  Hadrian,  a.d> 
772,  to  the  chancellor  of  the  emperor,  and 
afterwards  became  the  word  used  to  denote 
the  Papal  officers. — Hard.  Cone.  iii.  2017  r 
viii.  492. 

PROTOPAPAS ;  i.e.  archpriest :  the  head 
of  a  cathedralin  the  Eastern  Church,  answer- 
ins;  to  our  dean. 

PROVERBS,  THE.  A  canonical  book 
of  the  Old  Testament,  containing  the  Pro- 
verbs, or  wise  sayings,  of  Solomon,  the  sorb 
of  David,  king  of  Israel. 

This  collection  is  but  a  part  of  the  pro- 
verbs of  that  prince:  for  we  are  told  that 
"he  spake  three  thousand  proverbs,  and 
his  songs  were  a  thousand  and  five."  His 
name  is  prefixed  to  the  whole  work.  In 
the  twenty-fifth  chapter  it  is  observed,  that 
the  following  proverbs  belonged  to  him, 
but  that  they  were  collected  by  persons 
appointed  by  Hezekiah  for  that  purpose. 
The  thirtieth  chapter  is  entitled,  "  The- 
words  of  Agur,  the  son  of  Jakeh."  The 
last  chapter  is  inscribed,  "  The  words  of 
king  Lemuel."  Prom  these  different  titles 
it  is  concluded  that  the  first  twenty-four- 
chapters  are  the  genuine  work  of  Solo- 
mon ;  that  the  five  next  are  a  collection  of 
several  of  his  proverbs,  made  by  order  of 
King  Hezekiah;  and  that  the  two  last 
chapters  were  added,  and  belong  to  different,, 
though  unknown,  authors. 

The  Jews  are  of  opinion  that  Solomon- 
wrote  the  Canticles  in  his  youth,  the  Pro- 
verbs in  his  manhood,  and  the  Bcclesiastes 
in  the  latter  end  of  his  life.  The  Hebrews 
called  this  book  vEt?,  MishM,  taken  from 
the  first  word ;  the  Greeks  style  it  Tlapa^oKai,. 
and  the  Latins,  Proverbia;  which  may 
properly  be  rendered  sentences  or  maxims. 
They  contain  rules  for  the  conduct  of  all' 
conditions  of  life ;  for  kings,  courtiers, 
masters,  servants,  fathers,  mothers,  children, 
&o.  The  Greek  version  of  this  book  is  often 
very  different  from  the  Hebrew,  and  adds  a 
great  many  verses  that  are  not  found  in  the 
original.     In    the    ancient    Latin   editions- 


-e22 


PEOVIDENCE 


several  verses  are  added,  whicli  have  been 
left  out  since  the  time  of  St.  Jerome  (See 
Speaker's  Commentary ;  Smith's  Diet,  of 
BihU). 

PROVIDENCE.  The  superintendence 
■which  God  exercises  over  creation.  In  the 
very  notion  of  aCreator  this  power  is  implied. 
The  work  of  a  creature  may  continue  after 
its  author's  death:  because  the  work  of  a 
•creature  does  not  depend  upon  him  who  was 
the  author  of  it,  but  upon  some  pre-existing 
(things  which  were  not  created  by  him,  but 
merely  combined,  and  upon  the  laws  of 
nature,  which  are  all  laws  of  motion  which 
require  constant  maintenance.  A  house 
survives  the  architect  and  bmlder,  because 
the  pre-existing  things,  the  stones  for  in- 
stance, and  the  mortar,  remain  in  combi- 
mation.  But  the  works  of  God  are  iwt  only 
■combinations ;  they  are  creations ;  things 
formed  out  of  nothing.  Even  if  we  can 
believe  matter  to  be  self-existent,  its  pro- 
perties or  qualities  all  represent  forces  of 
some  kind,  which  .require  perpetual  main- 
itenance,  and  therefore,  Providence  (See  Sir 
Ji  Beckett's  Origin  of  Laws  of  Nature).  . 

PROVINCE.  The  limits  of  an  arch- 
ibishop's  jurisdiction,  as  the  diocese  is  the 
limits  of  the  jurisdiction  of  a  bishop :  and 
«G  provincial  constitutions,  provincial  courts, 
{provincial  synods,  provincial  canons,  are  the 
canons,  synods,  courts,  and  constitutions, 
TOhich  have  authority  within  the  rule  of  a 
.-single  archbishop  (See  Archbishop ;  Bishop). 

PROVISIONS.  An  oppressive  invention 
of  the  bishops  of  Rome,  whereby  the  right 
■of  patronage  of  ecclesiastical  benefices  was 
arbitrarily  suspended  by  the  pope,  that  he 
might  present  his  own  creatures,  and  make 
provision  in  the  Church  of  England  for 
foreign  ecclesiastics.  This  usurpation  of 
the  pope  occasioned  much  discontent  in  the 
Church  of  England ;  and  at  one  time  the 
«vil  had  become  so  intolerable,  that  it 
occasioned  frightful  disturbances.  The  pope 
(Gregory  IX.)  had  granted  a  provision  on 
the  patronage  of  one  Sir  Robert  Thwinge,  a 
Yorkshire  knight,  who  resented  it  so  highly 
as  to  associate  with  himself  some  eighty 
others,  who  had  received  the  like  treatment, 
by  whom  the  persons  of  foreign  ecclesiastics 
were  seized,  and  even  the  pope's  envoys 
murdered.  The  king,  Henry  III.,  set  him- 
self to  restore  peace;  and  Thwinge,  betaking 
himself  to  Rome,  was  reconciled  to  the  pope, 
a,nd  recovered  his  right  of  patronage ;  and 
the  pope  conceded  that  there  should  be  in 
future  no  provisions,  except  in  benefices  in 
the  patronage  of  ecclesiastical  persons  or 
bodies.  These  he  had  usually  found  more 
defenceless,  and  therefore  over  them  he  still 
exercised  his  usurped  authority.  Papal 
provisions  to  English  sees  were  very  com- 
mon during  the  reigns  of  Edward  I.  and  II. 


PKYMEE 

In  1351,  in  the  reign  of  Edward  III.,  the 
Statute  of  Provisors  was  passed,  which 
enacted  that  all  persons  receiving  papal 
provisions  should  be  liable  to  imprisonment ; 
and  it  was  re-enacted  in  1390.  But  it  was 
constantly  evaded  by  a,  collusion  between 
the  kings  and  the  popes ;  and  the  practice 
of  provision  was  not  extinguished  till  the 
reign  of  Henry  VII. 

PROVOST.  The  designation  of  heads  of 
some  colleges  in  our  universities  and  of  Eton. 
It  was  also  the  title  given  to  the  heads  of 
several  collegiate  churches  in  England,  sup- 
pressed at  the  Reformation,  and  was  their 
usual  designation  in  Scotland,  except  in 
cathedrals.  In  some  foreign  cathedrals  the 
head  of  the  chapter  is  the  provost,  though 
there  is  a  dean  besides;  and  in  others  the  dean 
is  head,  the  provost  subordinate.  The  latter 
was  formerly  the  case  in  five  out  of  the  six 
of  the  cathedrals  in  the  province  of  Tuam  : 
the  name  is  still  retained  in  some ;  in  others 
it  has  been  exchanged  for  that  of  precentor. 
Archdeacon  Cotton,  in  his  Fasti  Ecdesiai 
Hibernisa  (part  ii.  114),  says  that  the  title 
answered  to  that  of  chancellor.  This 
observation  seems  strengthened  by  the  fact 
that  the  dignity  of  chancellor  did  not  an- 
ciently exist  in  the  province  of  Tuam. 
Maillane,  in  his  Dictionnaire  de  Droit 
Canonique,  says  that  the  provost  had  the 
care  of  the  temporals,  the  dean  of  the  spiri- 
tuals ;  that  deans  were  established  to  take 
care  of  the  discipline  of  the  church,  and,  in 
many  chapters,  became  in  the  course  of  time 
the  first  in  rank.  In  Holland  and  else- 
where, before  the  Reformation,  the  provost 
was  sometimes  a  kind  of  archdeacon. 

PRYMER,  or  PRIMER  (Latin,  Pri- 
marius)  :  a  brief  manual  of  devotion,  and 
elementary  religious  instruction.  The 
earlier  Prymers  contained  (probably)  merely 
the  Creed,  Lord's  Prayer,  and  Ten  Com- 
mandments ;  the  later  ones  were  much 
fuller.  Vernacular  Prymers  exist  which 
were  written  as  far  back  as  the  lith  century. 
They  contained  the  hours,  the  dirge,  the 
seven  and  the  fifteen  psalms,  the  litany, 
commendations,  and  other  prayers.  Mr. 
Maskell  gives  an  account  of  a  Prymer  which 
was  in  his  possession  (now  in  the  British 
Museum)  of  the  date  1410.  Cambridge  has 
two  of  these  early  English  Prymers,  one  in 
the  University  library,  of  about  the  date  of 
1430,  the  other  in  the  library  of  Emmanuel 
College.  In  the  Bodleian  Library  at  Oxford 
there  are  four — Douce,  246  and  275,  Bodley, 
85,  and  Eawlinson,  699 ;  the  two  first  being 
of  about  date  1430,  the  last  not  earlier  than 
1460.  The  next  Prymer  seems  to  have  been 
that  called  the  "  Goodly  Prymer,"  which 
was  issued  in  1535. 

This  was  an  improved  edition  of  the 
former  ones,  and  contains,  among  a  great 


PSALMODY 

many  other  things,  an  exposition  of  the 
Ten  Commandments,  and  the  Creed,  and 
.the  Offices  for  the  Seven  Hours,  mainly 
iaken  from  the  old  offices ;  but  the  invoca- 
tion of  saints  is  omitted.  In  1537  was 
published  the  Institution  of  a  Christian 
Man,  a  still  further  advance.  In  1539  ap- 
peared a  Prymer  by  Hilsey,  a  Dominican 
friar,  afterwards  bishop  of  Rochester,  the 
subject,  though  not  the  form,  being  much 
the  same  as  in  the  first-mentioned  Prymer. 
It  contains  an  order  for  "  bidding  of  the 
beads  "  which  is  the  basis  of  our  "  bidding 
prayer  "  (y.  v.).  The  Epistles  and  Gospels 
were  to  a  certain  extent  re-aiTanged,  and 
this  alteration  was  followed  by  the  Ee- 
formers.  In  1545  King  Henry  VIII.'s 
Prymer  appeared.  The  services  for  the 
Hours  in  this  formed  the  basis  for  all 
future  Prymers,  and  were  much  the  same  as 
in  Queen  Elizabeth's  of  1559.  In  Edward 
VI.'s  reign  appeared,  in  1547,  a  reprint  of 
Henry  VIII.'s  Prymer;  in  1549,  1551, 
1552,  improved  editions,  with  omissions 
of  the  superstitious  invocations  of  the 
Virgin  Mary.  Queen  EUzabeth's  first 
Prymer,  1559,  was  a  reprint  of  King  Ed- 
ward's of  1551,  or  rather,  1552.  The  next, 
in  1566,  was  altered  a  good  deal  from  the 
former.  A  second  edition  was  published  in 
1575.  All  these  had  the  services  of  the 
Hours,  besides  litanies,  and  other  prayers. 
Some  the  catechism,  some  the  penitential 
psalms,  &c.  A  Latin  Form  of  Prayer, 
like  the  Prymer,  was  published  by  autho- 
rity in  1560,  and  Preces  Privatje,  a  dis- 
tinct, though  similar  publication,  in  1564. 
The  last  Prpmer  which  appeared  (though 
not  under  that  name)  was  Dr.  (afterwards 
Bp.)  Cosin's  "  Collection  of  Private  Devo- 
tions :  in  the  practice  of  the  ancient  Church, 
called  the  Hours  of  Prayer ;  as  they  were 
after  this  manner  published  by  authority  of 
Queen  Elizabeth,  1560,"  &c.  This  was 
published  in  1627  by  command  of  King 
■Charles  I.  (See  Mr.  Clay's  edition  of 
Private  Pj-ayer,  &c.,  during  the  reign  of 
Elizabeth,  edited  for  the  Parker  Society ; 
Dr.  Burton's  Three  Primers;  Haskell's 
Mon.  Bit.  iii.  xl. ;  Annot,  P.  B.  i.  xxv. ; 
E.  Daniel,  p.  16).     [H.] 

PSALMODY.  The  art  or  act  of  singing 
psalms.  Psalmody  was  always  esteemed  a 
<X)nsiderable  part  of  devotion,  and  is 
mentioned  by  many  early  writers.  The 
disciples  sang  a  hymn  or  psalm  after  the 
last  supper  (St.  Mark  xiv.  26) ;  and  St. 
Ignatius  in  his  epistle  to  the  Ephesians 
plainly  implies  this  custom  on  the  part  of 
the  early  Christians.  Justin  Martyr,  Origen 
and  others  also  refer  to  it ;  and  though  the 
word  "  hymns"  is  used,  yet  Tertullian  speaks 
of  them  as  from  Holy  Scripture  {A^pol.  39), 
evidently  implying  the  Psalms ;    though 


PSALMS 


623 


hymns,  according  to  our  sense  of  the  word, 
were  also  used  (See  Hymns).  After  the 
first  three  centuries  the  mention  of  psalmody 
in  the  public  service  is  frequent:  and  in 
one  council  none  other  than  passages  from 
Scripture  were  permitted  {Cone.  Brae.  1, 
c.  12).  It  was  usually  performed  standing 
(St.  Aug.  Serm.  iii.  in  Ps.  xxxvi.);  and, 
generally  in  a  sort  of  plain  song,  with  slight 
inflexions  of  the  voice,  wliich  later  became 
more  florid  and  elaborate. — Bingham,  xiv. 
1,14. 

St.  Basil  speaks  of  it  thus  : — "  After  the 
confession  the  people  rise  from  prayer,  and 
proceed  to  psalmody,  dividing  themselves 
into  two  parts,  and  singing  by  turns 
{Ep.  63).  To  this  method  of  psalmody  St. 
Augustine  refers  when  he  speaks  of  the 
introduction  of  singing  "  secundum  morem 
orientalium  partium  "  (Conf.  lib.  ix.  c.  7). 
The  practice  of  dividing  the  choir  into  two 
sides,  singing  alternate  verses,  was  introduced 
into  the  Western  Church  at  Milan  by  St. 
Ambrose  (See  Amhrosian  Bite).  For  the 
three  methods  of  singing  the  Psalms,  see 
Chant.  In  the  Galilean  Church  the  history 
of  psalmody  is  given  by  Mabillon  (de  Cursu 
Qallicano  disquisitio),  but  what  influence 
the  Galilean  psalmody  had  in  England  it 
is  impossible  to  state.  In  a  MS.  in  the 
Cotton  Library,  Germanus  and  Lupus  are 
said  to  have  brought  the  Gallican  Cursus 
(which  would  include  psalmody)  into  the 
British  Churches  (Collier,  Eccl.  Hist.  i. 
cent.  V.  p.  112).  The  use  of  the  Gloria  Patri 
at  the  end  of  each  psalm  was  the  rule  in  the 
Gallican  Church,  as  at  present  in  the  Angli- 
can. St.  Augustine  would  probably  intro- 
duce the  Roman  cursus  ;  and  Bede  speaks  of 
psalmody  being  much  improved  by  John 
the  "  archicantor  "  of  St.  Peter's,  who  was 
sent  here  by  Pope  Agatho  (Hist.  iv.  18) ; 
but  beyond  this,  little  is  known  till  later 
times    (See  Music ;  Chant).     [H.] 

PSALMS.  TJw  Booh  of  Hymns.  Our 
word  Psalm  is  the  translation  of  two  .very 
diflierent  Hebrew  words.  The  first  DvnPlj 
Tehillem,  properly  means  praises,  and  is  the 
title  of  the  book.  The  other,  "liPTD^ 
Mizmor,  means  a  poem,  but  is  onlv  found 
in  the  headings  of  certain  Psalms.  Psalm  is 
derived  from  a  Greek  verb,  -^aXKa,  which 
means  to  play  or  sing  to  an  instrument, 
being  very  appropriate  to  these  sacred  songs, 
which  we  know  from  Holy  Scripture  were 
sung  to  harps,  and othermusical  instruments. 
The  Book  of  Psalms  is  a  collection  of  hymns 
or  sacred  songs  in  praise  of  God,"and  consists 
of  poems  of  various  kinds.  They  are  the 
production  of  different  persons,  but  are 
generally  called  "the  Psalms  of  David," 
because  a  great  part  of  them  was  composed 
by  him,  and  David  himself  is  distinguished 
by  the  name  of  the  Psalmist.    We  cannot 


624 


PSALTEK 


now  ascertain  all  the  psalms  written  by- 
David,  but  their  number  probably  exceeds 
seventy.  They  are  divided  into  (1)  those 
of  the  first  period  of  his  life  (vii.  xi.  xii.  xiii. 
xvi.  (?)  xvii.  xxii.  xxiii.  (?)  xxxiv.  xxxv. 
lii.  liv.  Ivi.  Ivii.  lix. ;  (2)  those  of  the 
2nd  period,  between  his  accession  to  the 
throne  and  his  great  sin  (viii.  ix.  x.  xv.  to 
xxi.  inclusive,  xxiii.  xxiv.  xxvi.  xxix.  xxxvi. 
Ixiii.  Ix.  Ixviii.  oi.  c.  viii.  ex.) ;  (3)  those  of 
the  3rd  period,  from  David's  fall  to  his  flight 
(v.  vi.  xxxii.  xxxviii.  to  xli.  li.  Iv.  Ix.  Ixix.) ; 
(4)  those  written  probably  at  the  time  of 
his  flight  or  before  his  restoration  (iii.  iv. 
xxvii.  xxviii.  xxxi.  Ixi.  Ixiii.  Ixix.  Ixx. 
cxliii.) ;  (5)  those  belonging  to  the  last  period 
of  his  reign.  And  much  less  are  we  able 
to  discover  with  any  certainty  the  authors  of 
the  other  psalms,  or  the  occasion  upon  which 
they  were  composed ;  a  few  of  them  were 
written  after  the  return  from  the  Babylonian 
captivity.  And  the  ninetieth  psalm,  as  its 
title  in  the  original  in  our  Bible  translation 
shows,  is  attributed  to  Moses.  The  theory 
that  many,  or  even  most  of  them  were 
written  in  the  Maccabeau  age,  upheld  by 
Olshausen  and  other  commentators,  is  re- 
futed in  the  Speaker's  Commentary  (vol.  iv. 
p.  158).  There  is  no  subject  upon  which 
learned  men  are  so  much  at  variance  as  the 
authorship  of  the  Psalms,  and  the  meaning 
of  their  titles.  It  is  clear,  however,  that 
they  may  be  divided  into  the  following 
classes  :  Psalms  of  David ;  Psalms  or  Songs 
of  the  Sons  of  Korah ;  Psalms  of  Asaph ; 
Songs  of  Degrees ;  and  again  into  Peni- 
tential Psalms,  Hallelujah  Psalms,  and 
Historical  Psalms.     [H.] 

The  whole  collection  of  psalms,  usually 
divided  into  five  books,  is  eminently  pro- 
phetical of  the  MESSIAH.  The  first  book 
begins  with  the  1st  and  ends  with  the  41st 
psalm,  and  the  Hebrew  word  Le-David  (of 
or  concerning  David,  or  ty  David)  occurs 
before  almost  every  psalm.  The  2nd  book 
begins  with  the  42nd  psalm,  the  3rd  with 
the  73rd  psahn,  the  4th  with  the  90th 
psalm,  and  is  continued  to  the  106th.  The 
5th  and  last  book  opens  with  the  107th. 
The  seven  penitential  psalms  are,  6,  32,  38, 
51,  102,  130, 143.  These  are  appointed  to 
be  read  in  our  Church  on  Ash- Wednesday. 
For  many  ages  they  had  been  used  in  the 
Western  churches  in  token  of  special  humi- 
liation (See  Alphabetical  or  Acrostical 
Psalms,  and  Songs  of  Degrees ;  Korah, 
Psalms  of;  Asaph,  Psalms  of;  and 
Hallelujah). — Hengstenberg  on  the  Psalms ; 
Dean  Perowne;  Smith's  Diet,  of  Bible; 
Speaker's  Commentary. 

PSALTER.  I.  The  word  Psalter  is  often 
used  by  ancient  writers  for  the  Book  of 
Psalms,  considered  as  a  separate  book  of 
Holy  Scripture.     It  afterwards  assumed  a 


PSALTER 

more  technical  meaning,  as  the  book  in 
which  the  Psalms  are  arranged  for  the- 
service  of  the  Church.  The  Roman  Psalter, 
for  instance,  does  not  follow  the  course  of 
the  Psalms  as  in  Scripture;  they  are  ar- 
ranged for  the  different  services,  in  the 
several  accompaniments,  as  antiphons,  &c. 
In  our  Psalter,  the  notice  of  the  divisions 
for  the  days  of  the  month,  and  the  pointing^ 
in  the  middle  of  each  verse,  are  a  part  of 
the  Psalter,  though  not  of  the  Psalms;  and 
some  part  of  the  Psalms  unsuitable  for  reci- 
tation are  omitted,  as  the  titles,  the  words- 
Selah,  Higgaion,  &c.,  and  the  Hallelujahs, 
with  which  many  Psalms  begin  or  end,  or 
both.  The  division  of  the  Psalms  into  daily 
portions,  as  given  in  our  Prayer  Books,  has 
been  done  with  a  view  to  convenience. 
Something  like  this  has  long  prevailed  in. 
the  Church,  but  without  its  regularity  and. 
system.  Thus  in  Egypt  at  first,  in  some 
places,  they  read  60  Psalms ;  in  others,  50  ; 
and  afterwards  they  all  agreed  to  recite  12 
only.  Columbanus,  in  his  rule,  appointed 
the  number  of  Psalms  to  vary  according  to 
the  seasons  of  the  year,  and  the  length  of 
the  nights;  so  that  sometimes  75  were 
sung.  In  the  monasteries  of  Armenia  they 
repeat  99  Psalms  to  the  present  day.  In 
the  Greek  Church,  the  Psalms  are  divided, 
into  cathismata,  or  portions,  so  that  the 
whole  book  is  read  through  in  a  fortnight. 
In  the  Western  Church  the  plan  which 
prevailed  from  the  6th  century  do-nm  to  the 
Reformation  provided  for  the  Recitation  of 
the  whole  of  the  Psalms  every  week ;  but 
this  arrangement  was  perpetually  broken 
into  on  the  numerous  festivals,  and  hence- 
many  of  the  Psalms  were  never  had  at  alL 
That  this  existed  in  England  may  be  seen 
from  the  preface  to  the  Prayer  Book  of  1549, 
"  now  of  later  time  a  few  of  them  have  been 
daily  said,  the  rest  omitted ;  and  it  is  the 
case  in  the  Church  of  Rome  to  this  day. 
Under  the  present  arrangement  the  Psalms 
are  divided  into  60  portions,  two  of  which 
are  appointed  for  each  day  of  the  month. 
Selections  are  also  set  forth  by  the  Ameri- 
can Church,  which  may  be  used  instead  Of 
the  regularly  appointed  portions. 

II.  The  Psalter,  properly  speaking,  is  a 
separate  book  from  that  of  Common  Prayer ; 
though  bound  up  in  the  same  volume,  and 
equally  subscribed  to  by  all  the  clergy. 
The  title-page  of  the  Prayer  Book  announces 
the  Book  of  Common  Prayer,  &c.,  &o., 
together  with  the  Psalter,  &c.  The  Prayer 
Book  and  the  Psalter  were  not  included  in  the 
title-page  till  the  last  review.  It  is  remark- 
able that  the  same  causes  have  had  the 
same  effeijts  in  influencing  the  translation 
of  the  Psalter  both  in  the  Latin  and  the 
English  Church.  In  the  former,  the  old 
I  Italic  translation,  so  called  by  St.  Augustine 


PSALTER 

(^De  Boct.  CJirist.  ii.  15),  had  become  so 
familiar  to  the  people  that  St.  Jerome's 
translation  from  the  Hebrew  was  never 
adopted;  but  the  old  version,  corrected 
considerably  by  St.  Jerome,  was  used.  St. 
Jerome  left  three  versions ;  which  have  been 
called  the  Roman,  the  Gallican,  and  the 
Hebrew.  The  Roman  was  merely  the  old 
Italic  version  corrected  (by  request  of  St. 
Damasus  when  St.  Jerome  was  at  Rome, 
A.D.  383) ;  this  was  used  in  the  churches  of 
the  city  of  Rome  down  to  the  16th  century, 
and  is  stiU  used  in  the  church  of  the  Vatican 
And  in  St.  Mark's,  Venice.  The  G-allican 
version  was  in  the  course  of  time  adopted 
by  the  whole  Western  Church,  though  it 
■was  long  before  it  superseded  the  "Old 
Italic"  version.  It  was  translated  from 
Origen's  edition  of  the  LXX.,by  St.  Jerome, 
A.D.  389 ;  was  introduced  into  Germany  and 
<jraul  either  by  Gregory  of  Tours,  in  the  6th 
century ;  or  St.  Boniface  (the  English  apostle 
of  Germany)  in  the  8th.  From  France  it 
was  brought  over  to  England,  where,  how- 
•ever,  it  did  not  supersede  the  older  Italic 
version  till  the  revision  of  the  offices  by  St. 
Osmond,  in  the  12th  century.  ■  Translations 
into  Enghsh  were  made,  especially  in  the 
case  of  the  fifty-two  Psalms  of  the  Prymer 
(See  Prymer).  Wiclif  prefixed  to  his 
translation  of  the  New  Testament,  the  Old 
Testament  translated  from  the  old  Latin 
version  (See  Bible).  This  was  the  basis 
of  other  translations,  and  the  present  version 
■of  the  Prayer  Book  Psalter  is  that  of  Tyndal 
and  Goverdale,  which  was  revised  by  Arch- 
bishop Cranmer  and  called  the  "  Translation 
-of  the  Great  English  Bible,  set  forth  and 
used  in  the  time  of  King  Henry  VIII.,  and 
Edward  VI."  (See  Preface  to  tJie  Psalter  in 
-the  Prayer  Book).  This  has  ever  since  been 
used;  its  smooth  and  melodious  cadences 
being  better  suited  for  musical  purposes 
than  the  more  correct,  but  harsher  au- 
thorized version.  In  the  "Preface  to  the 
Psalter"  the  words  occur  "foUoweth  the 
■division  of  the  Hebrews."  There  have  been 
three  distinct  arrangements  of  the  Psalms: 
the  Hebrew  followed  in  our  Prayer  Book: 
the  Greek  ia  which  Pss.  ix.  and  x.,  cxiv., 
and  cxv.  are  joined,  and  Pss.  cxvi.  and 
cxlvii.  are  each  divided  into  two,  followed 
in  the  GaUican  version  of  St.  Jerome ;  and 
the  Syriac  version,  in  which  Pss.  cxiv.  and 
cxv.  are  joined,  and  Ps.  cxlvii.  is  divided. 
In  both  the  latter  Psalters  an  apocryphal 
psalm  is  included,  which  is  rejected  by 
us. 

The  Psalms  are  pointed  as  they  are  to  be 
■said  or  sung  in  churches;  by  which  is 
meant  the  colon  in  the  middle  of  each 
verse,  indicating  the  pause  to  be  made,  not 
only  in  the  chant,  but  also  in  the  recitation, 
as  the  words  clearly  imply;   a  direction 


PUBLIC  WORSHIP 


625 


commonly  neglected  by  readers,  to  the 
great  prejudice  of  distinct  enunciation. 

The  custom  of  repeating  the  Psalms 
alternately,  or  verse  by  verse,  between 
the  minister  and  the  people,  is  probably 
designed  to  supply  the  place  of  the  ancient 
antiphon,  or  the  responsive  chantino-  of  the 
psalms  by  two  distinct  choirs.  This  latter 
practice  is  still  retained  in  the  cathedrals  of 
England,  and  is  more  primitive  than  the 
alternate  reading  now  prevailiog  in  parish 
churches. — Wheatly,  128;  Palmer,  Orig. 
Liturg.  i.  207 :  Introd.  to  Psalter ;  Blunt, 
Annot.  P.  B. ;  E.  Daniel's  P.  B.  For  the 
history  of  ancient  Psalters  see  Dr.  Swainson's 
article  in  Bid.  Christ.  Ant.      [H.] 

PUBLIC  WORSHIP.  The  laws  now  in 
force  may  be  stated  as  follows : — 

Article  20.  "  The  Church  hath  power  to 
decree  rites  and  ceremonies"  that  are  not 
"  contrary  to  God's  word."  But  that  power 
has  long  ceased  in  the  Church  of  England, 
except  by  Act  of  Parliament  (See  below  as 
to  Act  of  Uniformity). 

Article  34.  "It  is  not  necessary  that 
traditions  and  ceremonies  be  in  all  places 
one  or  utterly  like;  for  at  all  times  they 
have  been  divers,  and  may  be  changed 
according  to  the  diversity  of  countries, 
times,  and  men's  manners ;  so  that  nothing 
be  ordained  against  God's  word.  Whoso- 
ever through  his  private  judgment  wil- 
lingly and  purposely  doth  openly  break  the 
traditions  and  ceremonies  of  the  Church, 
which  be  not  repugnant  to  the  word  of  God, 
and  be  ordained  and  approved  by  common 
authority,  ought  to  be  rebuked  openly 
(that  others  may  fear  to  do  the  like),  as  he 
that  ofi'ends  against  the  common  order  of 
the  Church,  and  hurts  the  authority  of  the 
magistrate,  and  wounds  the  consciences  of 
weak  brethren.  Every  particular  or  national 
Church  hath  authority  to  ordain,  change, 
and  aboHsh  the  ceremonies  or  rites  of  the 
Church,  ordained  only  by  man's  authority ; 
so  that  all  things  be  done  to  edifying." 

Canon  14.  "  The  common  Prayer  shall  be 
said  or  sung  distinctly  and  reverently,  upon 
such  days  as  are  appointed  to  be  kept  holy 
by  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer,  and  their 
eves,  and  at  convenient  and  usual  times  of 
those  days,  and  in  such  i^laces  of  every 
church  as  the  bishop  of  the  diocese  or 
ecclesiastical  ordinary  of  the  place  shall 
think  meet  for  the  largeness  or  straitness  of 
the  same,  so  as  the  people  may  be  most 
edified.  All  ministers  likewise  shall  observe 
the  orders,  rites,  and  ceremonies  prescribed 
in  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer,  as  well  in 
reading  the  Holy  Scriptures  and  saying  of 
prayers,  as  in  administration  of  the  sacra- 
ments, without  either  diminishing  in  regard 
of  preaching,  or  in  any  other  respect,  or 
adding  anything  in  the    matter  or   form 

2  s 


62G 


PUBLIC  WORSHIP 


thereof."    This  is  included  in  the  Act  of 
Uniformity. 

Canon  18.  "  No  man  shall  cover  his  head 
in  the  church  or  chapel  in  the  time  of 
Divine  service,  except  he  have  some  in- 
firmity; in  which  case  let  him  wear  a  night- 
cap, or  coif.  All  manner  of  persons  then 
present  shall  reverently  kneel  upon  their 
knees,  when  the  general  confession.  Litany, 
or  other  prayers  are  read ;  and  shall  stand 
up  at  the  saying  of  the  Belief,  according  to 
the  rules  in  that  behalf  prescribed  in  the 
Book  of  Common  Prayer.  And  likewise 
when  in  time  of  Divine  service  the  Lord 
Jesus  shall  be  mentioned,  due  and  lowly 
reverence  shall  be  done  by  aU  persons 
present,  as  it  hath  been  accustomed :  testi- 
fying by  these  outward  ceremonies  and 
gestures  their  inward  humility,  Christian 
resolution,  and  due  acknowledgment  that 
the  Lord  Jesus  Christ,  the  true  eternal  Son 
of  God,  is  the  only  Saviour  of  the  world,  in 
whom  alone  all  -the  mercies,  graces,  and 
promises  of  God  to  mankind,  for  this  life 
and  the  life  to  come,  are  fuUy  and  wholly 
comprised.  And  none,  either  man,  woman, 
or  child,  of  what  calling  soever,  shall  be 
otherwise  at  such  times  busied  in  the  church 
than  in  quiet  attendance  to  hear,  mark,  and 
understand  that  which  is  read,  preached,  or 
ministered;  saying  in  their  due  places 
audibly  with  the  minister  the  Confession, 
the  Lord's  Prayer,  and  the  Creed,  and 
making  such  other  answers  to  the  public 
prayers  as  are  appointed  in  the  Book  of 
Common  Prayer  :  neither  shall  they  disturb 
the  service  or  sermon,  by  walking,  or  talk- 
ing, or  any  other  way ;  nor  depart  out  of 
the  church  during  the  time  of  Divine  service 
or  sermon,  without  some  urgent  or  reason- 
able cause. 

And  by  the  preface  to  the  Book  of  Com- 
mon Prayer :  "  All  priests  and  deacons  are 
to  say  daily  the  Morning  and  Evening 
Prayer,  either  privately  or  openly,  not  being 
let  by  sickness,  or  some  other  urgent  cause. 
And  the  curate  that  ministereth  in  every 
parish  church  or  chapel,  being  at  home,  and 
not  being  otherwise  reasonably  hmdered, 
shall  say  the  same  in  the  parish  church  or 
chapel  where  he  ministereth ;  and  shall 
cause  a  bell  to  be  tolled  thereunto,  a  con- 
venient time  before  he  begin,  that  the 
people  may  come  to  hear  God's  word,  and  to 
pray  with  him." 

By  the  2  &  3  Edward  VL  c.  1,  and  1 
Elizabeth,  c.  2,  which  are  kept  alive  in  the 
present  Act  of  Uniformity,  and  applied  to 
the  Prayer  Book  of  1662,  it  is  enacted  as 
follows :  "  If  any  parson,  vicar,  or  other 
whatsoever  minister,  that  ought  or  should 
sing  or  say  Common  Prayer  mentioned  in 
the  same  book,  or  minister  the  sacraments, 
refuses  to  use  the  said  Common  Prayers,  or 


PUBLIC  WOESHIP 

to  minister  the  sacraments  in  such  cathedral 
or  parish  chruch,  or  other  places,  as  he 
should  use  to  minister  the  same  in  such 
order  and  form  as  may  be  mentioned 
and  set  forth  in  the  said  book ;  or  shall, 
wilfully  or  obstinately  standing  in  the- 
same,  use  any  other  rite,  ceremony,  order, 
form,  or  manner  of  celelDrating  the  Lord's 
supper,  openly  or  privily,  or  matins,  even- 
song, administration  of  the  sacraments, 
or  other  open  prayer,  than  is  mentioned 
and  set  forth  in  the  said  book ;  or  shall 
preach,  declare,  or  speak  anything  in  the 
derogation  or  depraving  the  said  book,  or 
anything  therein  contained,  or  of  any  part 
thereof;  and  shall  be  thereof  lawfully 
convicted,  according  to  the  laws  of  this 
realm,  by  verdict  of  twelve  men,  or  by  hi& 
oivn  confession,  or  by  the  notorious  evidence 
of  the  fact,  he  shall  forfeit  to  the  king,  for 
his  first  offence,  the  profit  of  such  one  of 
his  spiritual  benefices  or  promotions  as  it 
shall  please  the  king  to  appoint,  coming: 
or  arising  in  one  whole  year  after  his 
conviction,  and  also  be  imprisoned  for  sis 
months;  and  for  his  second  offence  be  im- 
prisoned for  a  year,  and  be  deprived,  ipso 
facto,  of  all  his  spiritual  promotions,  and  the 
patron  shall  present  to  the  same  as  if  he 
were  dead ;  and  for  the  third  offence  shall 
be  imprisoned  during  life."  But  by  sec. 
7  of  2  &  3  Edw.  VI.  any  psalm  or  prayer 
out  of  the  Bible  may  be  read,  though  it 
is  not  in  the  Prayer  Book. 

The  new  form  of  subscription  established 
by  the  Clerical  Subscription  Act  of  1865,. 
and  adopted  by  a  new  canon  (36)  soon  after, 
is:  "I  do  solemnly  make  the  following- 
declaration:  I  assent  to  the  Thirty-nine 
Articles  of  Keligion,  and  to  the  Book  of 
Common  Prayer.  I  believe  the  doctrine  of  the 
Church  of  England  as  therein  set  forth  to  be 
agreeable  to  the  word  of  God  ;  and  in  public 
prayer  and  administration  of  the  Sacrament 
I  will  use  the  form  in  the  said  book  pre- 
scribed and  none  oilier,  except  so  far  as  shall 
be  orderedby  lawful  authority."  This  is  called 
the  Declaration  of  Assent,  and  is  to  be  made 
and  signed  at  every  ordination,  and  institu- 
tion, and  appointment  to  a  curacy,  together 
with  taking  the  oath  of  allegiance  and  supre- 
macy prescribed  by  the  Act  (now  of  1868),, 
c.  72  (See  Reading  in;  Supremacy).  And  as 
to  public  worship  it  only  repeats  the  injunc- 
tion of  the  Acts  of  Uniformity  (for  they  are 
consolidated  by  the  last  of  them  (14  Car.  II. 
c.  4))  that  all  ministers ...  be  bound  to  say  and' 
use  the  [Prayer  Book  as  established]  in  such 
order  as  is  mentioned  in  the  said  book  .  .  . 
and  none  other  or  otherwise.  And  as  the 
Shortened  Services  Act,  called  the  Act  of 
Uniformity  Amendment  Act,  1872,  does  not 
authorise  any  additional  prayers,  it  is  quite- 
plain  that  none  except  those  in  the  Prayer 


PUBLIC  WOESHIP  ACT 

Book  (or  Bible,  which  are  allowed  both  by 
that  and  the  Act  of  Uniformity)  can  lawfully 
be  used,  and  that  any  such  are  contrary  to  the 
Acts  of  Parliament,  the  Canons,  and  the 
solemn  promise  of  every  clergyman  at  his 
ordinations.  That  Act  however  for  the 
first  time  authorised  hymns  as  distinct  from 
anthems.  Not  even  the  Old  or  New  "Versions 
of  the  Psalms  had  ever  been  statutably 
authorised  before.  It  is  not  lawful  however 
to  interject  hymns  anywhere,  so  as  to  inter- 
rupt parts  of  the  service  which  are  contin- 
uous in  the  Prayer  Book.  A  varied  form 
of  service,  but  still  no  new  prayers,  may  be 
allowed  by  the  bishop  at  a  third  service  on 
Sundays  and  holy  days.  Subject  to  these 
limitations,  the  conduct  of  public  worship 
xmdoubtedly  lies  with  the  incumbent  of  the 
chmrch,  both  as  to  music  and  other  things. 
Neither  churchwardens  nor  organists  have 
a  right  to  interfere  or  to  act  contrary  to  the 
orders  of  the  incumbent  so  long  as  they 
are  not  unlawful,  and  an  organist  would  be 
at  once  condemned  by  the  ecclesiastical  court 
who  did  so,  as  churchwardens  have  been  for 
interfering.  Their  only  right  is  to  complain 
to  the  ordinary.     [Gr.] 

PUBLIC  WORSHIP  EEGULATION 
ACT,  1874,  has  been  probably  the  greatest 
failure  and  series  of  blunders  ever  enacted, 
even  in  ecclesiastical  legislation,  which  in 
modern  times  has  been  prolific  of  them.  Its 
professed  origin  was  the  recommendation  of 
what  was  called  the  Bitual  Commission  of 
1869,  the  same  which  made  the  new  Lec- 
tionary  (see  Lessons),  that  "measures  should 
be  taken  to  restrain  ritual  excesses ;  "  and  a 
further  though  unavowed  reason  for  it  was 
the  frequent  reversals  of  the  then  Dean  of 
Arches  by  the  Judicial  Committee  of  the 
Privy  Council.  The  bill  as  brought  in  by 
the  two  archbishops  was  essentially  differ- 
ent from  the  Act  which  it  was  turned  into 
by  "  amendments  "  in  the  House  of  Lords, 
which  were  chiefly,  but  not  all,  due  to  the 
then  Lord  Chancellor  Cairns.  The  first 
thing  that  it  did  was  practically  to  supersede 
the  two  existing  provincial  judges  by  a 
single  new  one,  who  was  to  exercise  all  the 
old  jurisdiction  and  some  new,  and  was  to 
be  appointed  from  time  to  time  by  the  two 
archbishops  jointly,  with  the  approval  of 
the  Crown,  and  by  the  Crown  alone,  if  they 
did  not  appoint  within  six  months — an  en- 
tire usurpation,  and  less  necessary  than  ever 
when  they  both  had  to  concur;  for  they 
would  hardly  concur  in  making  a  bad  ap- 
pointment. And  to  that  piece  of  usurpation 
a  great  deal  of  the  clerical  opposition  to  the 
Act  has  been  due,  whether  justly  or  not. 
The  objection  to  requiring  both  archbishops 
to  concur  in  appointing  a  single  judge  can 
hardly  be  stated  so  as  to  have  a  rational 
appearance ;  but  that  is  quite  different  from 


PUBLIC  WOItSHIP  ACT 


027 


the  usurpation  of  both  appointments  by  the 
Prime  Minister  if  he  chooses.  It  is  incon- 
ceivable how  such  a  thing  was  allowed  to 
pass  without  a  word  of  objection  from  the  bi- 
shops. From  the  evidence  before  the  Commis- 
sion on  Ecclesiastical  Courts  in  1882,  there 
seems  reason  to  doubt  whether  even  the  two 
primates  were  aware  of  it  (see  p.  263,  Ev.). 
Although  the  Act  was  intended  to  simplify 
proceedings  in  the  ecclesiastical  courts,  it 
somehow  became  overloaded  with  absurd 
technicalities  which  have  become  constant 
pitfalls  for  mistakes  and  costs  and  failures ; 
and  worst  of  all,  no  efiective  action  can  take 
place  under  it  against  a  clergyman  who 
chooses  to  resist  and  to  defy  imprisonment, 
in  less  than  three  years,  for  deprivation  is  not 
incurred  for  disobedience  till  that  time. 
Only  one  such  dejirivation  has  accordingly 
taken  place,  and  probably  the  Act  is  alto- 
gether obsolete  already  except  aa  to  the  de- 
struction (as  many  of  the  clergy  insist)  of 
the  ecclesiastical  character  of  the  provincial 
judge  by  that  usurpation  of  the  Crown.  At 
the  same  time  it  is  only  fair  to  say  that 
ever  since  the  Reformation  the  whole  of 
the  supreme  or  final  tribunal,  however  it 
was  constituted  from  time  to  time,  has 
been  appointed  by  the  Crown,  for  300  years 
without  any  limitation  whatever,  and  since 
1833  with  the  limitations  imposed  by  the 
Act  for  the  Judicial  Committee, and  nobody 
ever  thought  of  objecting  to  it  until  the 
Judicial  Committee  decided  the  Gorham 
case  (see  Delegates  and  Judicial  Committee), 
when  some  clergymen  suddenly  discovered 
that  it  was  no  longer  an  ecclesiastical  court, 
though  nobody  had  ever  denied  the  unlimited 
Delegates  to  be  one. 

Another  wonderful  feature,  or  rather  two, 
of  the  P.  W.  E.  Act,  are,  that  although  pro- 
ceedings may  still  be  taken  under  the  old 
law  to  remove  unlawful  structures  in  a 
chm'ch  at  any  time,  and  proceedings  for  de- 
privation may  be  instituted  by  anybody, 
with  the  bishop's  consent  since  1840,  yet 
if  they  are  taken  under  this  Act  they 
can  only  be  by  three  parishioners  or  the 
bishop  or  archdeacon,  and  the  judge  can 
only  remove  illegal  structm-es  less  than  five 
years  old,  and  (as  said  just  now)  cannot  de- 
prive at  once,  but  only  go  on  issuing  moni- 
tions and  suspensions  to  be  disregarded  or 
defied  for  three  years.  The  sooner  such  a 
heap  of  legislative  nonsense  is  repealed  and 
turned  into  something  rational,  the  better, 
except  for  those  who  want  to  keep  ecclesiasti- 
cal law  ridiculous.  The  much-disputed  epi- 
scopal veto  on  clerical  prosecutions  was  im- 
ported into  this  Act  from  another  modern  one, 
the  Clergy  Disciplme  Act  of  1840.  Nobody 
seems  yet  to  have  remarked  that  the  legal 
effect  of  it  is,  that  any  bishop  may  order  or 
sanctionall  over  his  diocese  the  grossest  viola- 

2  s  2 


628 


PUBLIC  WORSHIP  ACT 


tioDS  of  tlie  law  either  in  the  way  of  omission 
or  commission :  may  issue  an  entirely  new 
service  book,  \nth.  an  intimation  that  clergy- 
men who  wish  for  his  approval  had  tetter 
use  it :  may  authorise  them  to  wear  gowns 
or  even  red  coats  instead  of  surplices  in  "  all 
their  ministrations,"  and  in  short  to  do  any- 
thing which  is  only  a  clerical  offence.  The 
one  thing  that  the  bishop  could  not  override 
the  law  in  is  the  one  thing  which  one  bishop 
declared  in  convocation  that  he  meant  to  do, 
and  was  for  a  short  time  upheld  by  a  bare 
majority  of  bishops,  viz.  to  authorise  lay- 
men to  conduct  the  service  in  church.  That 
is  not  a  clerical  offence,  and  the  layman 
could  be  restrained  by  monition  at  the  suit 
of  any  parishioner.  A  Dean  of  Arches  once 
monished  a  layman  from  performing  a 
funeralin  a  church-yard,  under  the  common 
law  of  the  church — of  course  before  the 
Burials  Act  of  1880.  On  the  other  hand,  it 
is  a  delusion  to  suppose  that  a  layman  needs 
any  licence  to  perform  all  the  service  in  any 
unconsecrated  building,  or  that  a  bishop's 
licence  to  him  has  any  legal  effect  whatever. 
And  it  is  another  common  delusion,  that 
buildings  are  licensed.  They  are  not;  but 
by  long  usage  and  unwritten  law  somewhat 
anomalous  (as  Sir  J.  NichoU  said),  bishops 
may  licence  either  incumbents,  or  other 
specified  clergymen  with  their  consent,  to 
perform  service  in  specified  unconsecrated 
buildings,  such  as  the  proprietary  chapels  in 
London,  and  may  withdraw  such  licenses  at 
will,  and  then  the  Court  will  prohibit  them, 
as  clergymen  have  been  censured  and  sus- 
pended for  officiating  in  dissenting  chapels 
in  England.  But  though  laymen  cannot  be 
prevented  from  officiating  in  what  are  called 
school  chapels,  and  a  licence  to  them  has 
no  legal  meaning,  bishops  can  and  some- 
times do  refuse  a  licence  to  any  clergyman 
to  officiate  there  also,  as  that  produces  con- 
fusion in  the  minds  of  the  people,  except 
perhaps  occasionally  to  prevent  the  service 
from  failing.  Probably  the  only  consecrated 
place  where  both  laymen  and  clergymen  can 
lawfully  officiate  is  the  "  private  chapel "  of 
great  houses,  but  those  are  not  open  to  the 
public,  and  are  recognised  by  Canon  71. 

It  is  astonishing  that  incumbents  should 
still  be  allowed  the  legal  power  to  prohibit 
other  clergymen  from  officiating,  even  by 
direction  of  the  bishop,  in  any  building  in 
their  parish  open  to  the  public,  or  to  more 
than  20  people  besides  the  family  of  the 
house,  except  in  the  chapels  of  colleges  and 
some  other  public  institutions,  under  a  recent 
Act.  So  that  a  bad  incumbent  may  de- 
stroy the  Church  of  England  over  many 
square  miles,  and  there  is  absolutely  no 
remedy  if  he  is  not  bad  enough  to  deprive, 
or  if  the  bishop  chooses  to  veto  a  prosecution 
of  him.    The  Act  18  &  19  Vic.  c.  86,  appears 


PUBGATORY 

at  first  sight  to  enable  an  incumbent  to  dis- 
pense with  a  licence  for  himself  or  his  curate 
to  officiate,  in  a  school  chapel  for  instance, 
but  it  does  not :  it  only  relieves  them  from 
certain  penalties  originally  enacted  against 
unlicensed  dissenting  chapels.  They  no 
longer  require  any  licence  (See  State 
Prayers').     [G.] 

PULPIT  (Lat.  pvXpitum,  a  stage:  Fr. 
pidpitre).  Sermons  were  originally  deliv- 
ered from  the  steps  of  the  altar,  which 
was  sometimes  called  the  Pulpitum,  a  term 
derived  from  the  ancient  theatres.  The 
ambones,  or  pulpits  of  the  primitive  Church, 
were  used  originally  for  reading  the  lessons 
only.  In  later  times  pulpits,  or  elevated 
desks,  were  erected  sometimes  in  the  choir, 
but  generally  in  the  nave,  for  the  purpose 
of  sermons.  In  our  Church  a  decent  and 
comely  pulpit  is  ordered  in  every  Church, 
from  which  the  preacher  addresses  his  flock, 
to  be  set  in  a  convenient  place  by  the 
direction  of  the  ordinary  (See  Canon  83). 

PUEGATORY.  A  supposed  state  or 
place  in  which  souls  after  death  are  by 
punishment  purged  from  their  sins  before 
they  can  go  to  heaven.  That  the  doctrine 
of  Purgatory  is  of  pagan  origin  is  shown  by 
many  heathen  authors,  as  for  instance  in 
the  well-known  passage  in  Virgil's  JEneid, 
"  Ergo  exercentur  poenis,  veterumque  mal- 
onim  Supplicia  expendunt,"  &c.  (-<£?«.  vi. 
739) ;  and  Plato  inculcated  it  in  the 
Phajdrus,  from  whence  the  Neo-Platonists 
took  their  ideas. 

The  teaching  of  our  Lord  and  His  Apos- 
tles was  simply  that  the  spirits  of  good  men 
on  leaving  the  body  are  received  into  paradise 
or  the  care  of  God,  and  that  those  of  the 
wicked  go  to  hell,  or  at  any  rate  into  some 
kind  of  penal  state,  waiting  for  the  final 
judgment.  2  St.  Pet.  ii.  9,  KoKaioii4vovs 
(See  E.  V.  and  Speaker's  Commentary).  But 
when  the  Neo-Platonic  ideas  gained  ground 
in  the  Church,  certain  of  the  Christians 
were  disposed  to  agree  with  the  Platonists 
— that  souls  of  men  without  baseness  or 
grossness,  after  death,  are  borne  aloft; 
the  others  sent  to  realms  below  until  every 
stain  should  be  purged  away.  For  Origen, 
the  Platonic  ideas  had  great  attraction, 
and  with  regard  to  this  matter,  he  held  that 
all  evil-doers,  even  devils,  were  to  be  eventu- 
ally purified  by  the  penal  processes  they 
are  undergoing,  and  thus  the  final  restitution 
of  all  things  is  to  be  the  complete  triumph 
of  a  purgatorial  system  over  all  the  deflections 
of  God's  rational  creatures  from  His  ovm 
inherent  holiness  (See  Soames'  Bampton 
Lectures,  pp.  314-339).  But  this  is  not  the 
mediaeval  idea  of  purgatory,  though  perhaps 
a  seed  which  brought  forth  some  fruit  in 
that  direction.  It  is  important  to  observe 
what  was  the  general  feehng  of  the  Church 


PUEGATOEY 

on  this  matter  in  the  eady  times.  It  is  not 
to  be  doubted  tliat  prayers  were  offered  for 
the  dead,  "  that  God  would  shew  them 
mercy,  and  hasten  the  resurrection,  and  give 
a  blessed  sentence  in  the  great  day."  But 
they  prayed  for  apostles,  holy  saints,  revered 
martyrs,  and  such  as  would  not,  according 
to  the  later  notion,  he  in  purgatory.  They 
prayed  that  all  might  pass  the  purgation  at 
the  last  day,  looking  to  certain  passages  in  the 
apostolic  epistles,  as  St.  Peter,  Ep.  ii.,  iii.  10, 
and  St.  Paul,  1  Cor.  iii.  11-15— "saved,  yet 
so  as  by  fire."  The  opinions  of  the  Fathers — 
for  it  must  be  remembered  that  they  were 
only  opinions,  and  not  made  a  doctrine  of 
the  Church  by  a  general  council — may  be 
thus  considered.  (1)  The  purgation  by 
fire.  "We  must  all,"  says  St.  Ambrose, 
"  pass  through  the  fire,  whether  it  is  John 
the  Evangelist,  whom  Jesus  loved,  or  others 
...  of  his  death  some  have  doubted;  of 
his  passing  through  the  fire,  none  can  doubt." 
In  the  same  way  SS.  Basil,  Hilary,  Jerome 
and  Lactantius,  wrote  affirming  "  that  men, 
Christ  only  excepted,  shall  be  burned  with 
the  fire  of  the  world's  conflagration  at  the 
day  of  judgment."  (2)  The  theory  which 
was  held  by  Justin  Martyr,  TertuUian, 
Victorinus  Martyr,  Prudentius,  St.  Chryso- 
stom,  and  others,  was  that  before  the  day  of 
judgment  the  souls  of  men  are  kept  in  secret 
receptacles,  reserved  unto  the  sentence  of  the 
great  day ;  and  that  before  then  no  man 
receives  according  to  his  work  done  in  this 
life  (Sixt.  Semens,  liv.,  vi. ;  Bibl.  Sand. 
Annot.  345).  The  Fathers  did  not  intend 
these  ideas  to  be  a  matter  of  faith,  but  they 
put  them  before  their  hearers  as  what  might 
be,  though  there  could  be  no  certainty  on 
the  matter.  But  the  whole  of  the  primi- 
tive opinion  seems  to  be  opposed  to  the 
idea  of  purgatory,  which  is  no  Catholic 
doctrine,  but  was  invented  in  later  times 
to  get  rid  of  the  difficulty  of  explaining 
the  intermediate  state,  and  in  the  corrupt 
ages  of  the  Church,  to  gain  a  power  by  the 
priests  over  the  people,  by  the  assumption 
that  masses  might  by  them  be  offered,  to 
alleviate  the  pains  of  souls  in  purgatory. 
It  is  now  constantly  the  custom  in  Romanist 
communities  to  pay  a  certain  sum  that 
masses  may  be  offered  for  the  benefit  of  the 
souls  of  those  who  are  supposed  to  be  in 
purgatory. 

The  Greek  Church  does  not  go  with  the 
Latin  Church  on  this  point,  and  does  not 
define  anything  dogmatically  en  the  state  of 
departed  souls  (King's  Rites  and  Ceremonies 
of  Qreek  Cliurcli  in  Russia,  p.  171).  "  The 
doctrine  of  the  Fathers,"  says  Palmer,  "  and 
of  the  early  Church,  of  the  present  Greek 
or  orthodox  Church,  and  of  the  other  sepa- 
rated Eastern  Churches,  is  this,  that  speak- 
ing generally,  and  upon  the  whole,  the  state 


PUEIFICATION 


629 


of  the  faithful  departed,  is  a  state  of  light,  and 
rest,  and  peace,  and  refreshment,  of  happi- 
ness far  greater  than  any  belonging  to  this  life,- 
yet  inferior  to  that  which  shall  be  enjoyed  after 
the  resurrection,  and  final  judgment.  The 
doctrine  of  the  Latins,  on  the  other  hand,  is 
this,  that  the  state  of  the  faithful  departed, 
and  of  others,  is  a  state  of  penal  torment, 
differing  from  that  of  hell  only  in  the 
certainty  of  future  deliverance "  (Palmer, 
Diss,  on  Ortho.  Comm.  p.  124). 

According  to  the  Romanists  the  departed 
have  to  make  an  atonement  themselves,  in 
the  purgatorial  state,  for  the  sins  they  have 
committed  when  in  this  life ;  but  the  primi- 
tive idea,  still  held  by  our  Church,  and  the 
Eastern  Church,  is  that  after  death  no 
purgatorial  work  can  be  done  by  those 
departed,  but  that  the  prayers  of  the  faithful 
will  benefit  them  in  the  intermediate  state 
(Williams'  Orthodox,  and  Non-jur.  p.  57). 

The  Roman  doctrine  is  thus  expounded 
by  the  Council  of  Trent : — "  If  any  one 
say,  that,  after  the  grace  of  justification 
received,  the  fault  is  so  pardoned  to  every 
penitent  sinner,  and  the  guilt  of  temporal 
punishment  is  so  blotted  out,  that  there 
remains  no  guilt  of  temporal  punishment  to 
be  done  away  in  this  world,  or  that  which 
is  to  come  in  purgatory,  before  the  passage 
can  be  opened  into  heaven,  let  him  be 
accursed."  And  elsewhere  it  is  asserted 
"  There  is  a  purgatory,  and  that  the  souls 
detained  there  are  helped  by  the  suffrages 
of  the  faithful,  but  principally  by  the 
sacrifices  of  the  acceptable  altar.  So  that, 
as  Bellarmine  says,  •  Purgatory/is  a  certain 
place,  in  which,  as  in  a  prison,  the  souls  are 
purged  after  this  life,  which  were  not 
fully  purged  in  this  life,  to  wit,  that  so  they 
may  be  able  to  enter  into  heaven,  where  no 
unclean  thing  enters  in."  So  according  to 
the  Tridentine  catechism  souls  are  said  to 
be  cruciate  in  purgatory;  but  the  primi- 
tive doctrine  was  that  they  were  detentse  in 
an  intermediate  state,  in  which  soul.«  are 
prepared  and  matured  for  the  final  judg- 
mHfrt;    [H.] 

PURIFICATION  OF  THE  VIRGIN 
MARY.  This  holy-day  is  kept  in  memory 
of  the  presentation  of  Christ  in  the  temple, 
and  is  observed  in  the  Church  of  England 
on  the  second  of  February.  It  was  a  precept 
of  the  Mosaic  law,  that  every  first-born  son 
should  be  holy  unto  the  Lord,  to  attend  the 
service  of  the  temple  or  tabernacle,  or  else 
to  be  redeemed  with  an  offering  of  money, 
or  sacrifice.  The  mother,  also,  was  obliged 
to  separate  herself  forty  days  from  the  con- 
gregation, after  the  birth  of  a  male,  and 
eighty  after  that  of  a  female ;  and  then  was 
to  present  a  lamb,  if  in  good  circumstances, 
or  a  couple  of  pigeons,  if  she  was  poor.  All 
this  was  exactly  performed  after  the  birth 


630 


PUKITANS 


of  our  Saviour,  who  came  to  fulfil  all 
righteousness ;  and  was  willing,  in  all  par- 
ticulars of  his  life,  that  a  just  obedience 
should  be  paid  to  the  public  ordinances  of 
religion.  The  offering  of  two  pigeons  made 
in  this  case  is  an  undesigned  coincidence 
attesting  the  poverty  of  His  parents.  This 
feast  is  of  considerable  antiquity,  the 
original  name  (still  used  in  the  Eastern 
Church)  being  Hjrpapante  (vnawavTrj),  i.e. 
the  meeting  of  our  Lord  with  Simeon  and 
Anna  in  the  Temple.  This  corresponds  more 
with  the  first  of  our  alternative  titles — "  The 
Presentation  of  our  Lord  in  the  Temple." 
It  was  probably  instituted  in  the  time  of 
Justinian  c.  a.d.  541  (Niceph.  lib.  xvii.  c. 
28 :  Baronius  Martyr :  Fleury,  liv.  xxxiii.). 
Gregory  of  Nazianzus  speaks  indeed  of 
the  feast  of  lights  (Naz.  40,  de  Bapt),  but 
he  is  apparently  referring  to  the  Epiphany 
(Bingham,  xx.  iv.  7).  The  sermons  of  St. 
Cyril  of  Alexandria  and  Gregory  Nyssen 
(c.  A.D.  370),  in  which  mention  is  made  of 
this  festival,  are  considered  spurious.  Dr. 
Neale  however  is  of  opinion  that  it  was  only 
transferred  by  Justinian  from  Feb.  14,  on 
which  it  had  been  previously  held,  to  Feb. 
2  {Holy  East.  Oh.  vol.  ii.  p.  771).  The; 
popular  name  of  this  festival  is  Candlemas 
Day,  because  of  an  ancient  custom  of  walk- 
ing in  procession  with  tapers  singing  hymns 
(See  Candlemas).  It  is  observed  as  one  of 
the  scarlet  days  in  the  Universities  of 
Oxford  and  Cambridge.     [H.] 

PUEITA2^S.  The  designation  of  Puri- 
tans was  given  to  a  party  in  the  Church  of 
England  in  the  sixteenth  and  seventeenth 
centuries,  who  maintained  that  the  English 
Church  was  still  disfigured  by  remnants  of 
Popery,  and  who  were  anxious  to  introduce 
into  the.  English  ecclesiastical  system  the 
severer  forms  of  worship  and  doctrine  which 
prevailed  among  the  Reformed  Churches 
abroad.  The  name  of  Puritans  was  first 
given  to  this  party  about  a.d.  1564  in  de- 
rision of  their  reiterated  assertion  that  their 
sole  desire  was  "pure"  doctrine  and  a 
"  pure  "  ecclesiastical  system ;  but,  although 
the  Puritans  only  crystalhsed  into  a  distinct 
party  in  the  sixteenth  century,  the  spirit  of 
Puritanism  may  be  discerned  two  centuries 
earlier  in  the  protests  made  by  Wiolif  and 
the  Lollards  against  the  corruption  of  the 
Koman  Church,  and  in  their  attack  upon 
the  doctrines  of  indulgences,  pardons,  abso- 
lutions, pilgrimages,  worship  of  images  and 
saints.  The  order  of  "  simple  priests,"  or- 
ganised by  Wiclif,  in  their  long  russet  gowns, 
diffused  their  master's  doctrines  with  won- 
derful rapidity.  This  religious  revival  was 
stamped  out  in  blood;  but  the  spirit  that 
inspired  it  appeared  again  in  the  Puritans  of 
the  16th  century,  who  may  be  defined  in  a 
general  way  as  consisting  of  all  who  thought 


PTJEITANS 

the  Reformation  had  not  been  carried  far 
enough,  and  wished  to  extend  it  on  Calvin- 
istic  lines,  being  content  with  nothing  short 
of  the  destruction  of  episcopacy,  and  the 
discarding  a  "  book  of  prayers."  The  latter 
was  an  early  cause  of  rupture.  In  1567 
Grindal,  then  bishop  of  London,  had  to 
complain  of  a  party  who  had  separated  from 
the  Church,  and  rejected  the  Book  of  Com- 
mon Prayer.  The  chief  objection  then  was 
the  use  of  wafer  cakes  in  the  Church  of 
England.  Grindal  reminded  the  Puritans 
that  those  same  wafer-cakes  were  used  in 
their  ideal  congregation  at  Geneva  (Strype's 
Grindal,  p.  107  :  Hook's  Archbishops,  x.  71). 
But  though  the  arm  of  the  law  was  exercised 
against  them,  and  several  Puritans  were 
committed  to  prison  (though  very  soon  dis- 
charged), the  wave  of  Puritanism  was  ad- 
vancing. During  the  reign  of  Elizabeth  the 
Puritans  were  firmly  and  successfully  re- 
sisted ;  and  when  James  succeeded  Elizabeth 
each  party  hoped  to  attach  him  to  their 
views.  The  Roman  Church  thought  that 
he  would  seize  the  opportunity  of  avenging 
the  woes  of  his  mother.  The  Puritans 
relied  on  the  care  with  which  he  had  been 
brought  up  in  the  doctrines  of  the  Reforma- 
tion. The  Episcopal  party  alone  were 
doubtful.  On  his  progress  into  England 
the  famous  Millenary  petition  (so  called 
from  an  exaggeration  of  the  number  of 
signatures  attached  to  it)  was  presented  to 
him  by  the  Puritan  party,  and  their  hopes 
were  raised  to  the  highest  pitch.  But  the 
answer  James  sent  to  the  deputation  of  the 
English  Church  which  was  sent  to  offer 
their  congratulations  reassured  Churchmen 
as  he  jiromised  to  maintain  the  Church  as 
Queen  Elizabeth  had  done.  In  January 
1604,  'the  famous  Hampton  Court  confer- 
ence met  under  the  presidency  of  the  king 
himself,  to  discuss  the  points  at  issue  be- 
tween the  Cliuroh  and  the  Puritan  body 
(See  Hampton  Court  Conference). 

The  Puritans,  conscious  of  the  weakness 
of  their  cause  and  the  ability  of  their 
opponents,  do  not  appear  to  have  presented 
their  case  in  any  detail.  And  the  king,  who 
did  not  conceal  his  animus  against  the 
Puritans,  at  the  end  of  the  third  day 
declared  the  objections  of  the  Puritans 
unreasonable  and  the  answer  of  the  bishops 
satisfactoi'y.  He  told  the  Puritans  that 
"  they  wished  to  strip  Christ  again,  and  bid 
them  away  with  their  snivelling."  "  I 
peppered  them  soundly,"  he  said  to  the 
bishops,  "  as  ye  have  done  the  Papists." 

But  Puritanical  ideas  waxed  stronger 
during  this  reign,  though  Bancroft,  a  man 
of  firmness  and  ability  upheld  to  the 
best  of  his  power,  the  authority  of  the 
Church.  His  famous  sermon  on  the  divinely 
constituted  authority  of  the  Church,  at  Paul's 


PUEITANS 

Cross  on  Feb.  9,  1589,  did  much  to  stay  the 
wave  of  Puritan  thouglit  in  the  Church,  and 
to  lay  the  foundations  of  a  revival  of  the 
Keformation  on  moderate  and  historical 
grounds. 

This  was  followed  up  by  Savaria  in  his 
"  Treatise  on  the  Various  Degrees  of  Mini- 
sters," &c. ;  it  is  the  fundamental  position  of 
Hooker's  "  Ecclesiastical  Polity ;"  and  it  was 
suppoited  by  the  elaborate  arguments  of 
Bishop  Bilson  ia  his  "  Perpetual  Government 
of  Christ's  Church,"  published  in  1594,  which 
was  followed  in  the  same  year  by  Bancroft's 
able  exposure  of  the  Presbyterian  platform 
and  of  the  "  Holy  Discipline "  in  his 
"  Dangerous  Positions."  Thus  the  tide  of 
so-called  Pmitanism  was  checked  for  the 
while,  and  what  was  still  more  important,  a 
school  of  youDg  clergy  was  trained  up  who 
were  able  to  maintain  the  principles  of  the 
Eeformation,  and  who  handed  on  their  trust 
to  the  great  Caroline  divines  who  so  ably 
maintained  the  struggle  of  their  own  day 
and  conquered  in  it.  But  Abbott,  who  suc- 
ceeded Bancroft  in  the  primacy,  was  a  Cal- 
vinist,  and  in  reality  was  opposed  to  the 
Episcopacy.  The  mistaken  judgment  which 
ruined  Charles  I.  gave  the  Puritans  the  as- 
cendency, which  they  exercised  as  soon  as 
they  could.  The  "Long  Parliament"  in 
1643  did  what  the  Puritans  wished ;  for  the 
•estates  of  bishops  were  confiscated  in  1646, 
and  the  use  of  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer 
was  abolished.  The  Restoration  was  in 
great  measure  due  to  the  hatred  of  the  Pmi- 
tans  which  the  nation  had  acquired  after  a 
few  years  of  sufficient  experience,  and  they 
fell  accordingly.  Twelve  of  their  represen- 
tatives were  allowed  to  discuss  the  proposed 
alterations  of  the  Prayer  Book,  with  the  same 
number  of  bishops  in  1661,  at  the  Savoy 
Conference  (See  Savoy  Conference) ;  and 
it  seems  that  the  word  "  retained  "  was  in- 
troduced into  the  "  Ornaments  Eubric,"  in 
■consequence  of  their  objection  that  the  rubric 
as  it  stood  in  James  I.'s  Prayer  Book  (of 
1604)  unratified  by  Parliament  "appeared 
to  bring  back  the  vestment"  of  the  first 
Edwardian  Prayer  Book,  which  had,  it  was 
supposed,  been  abolished  by  the  Elizabethan 
Advertisements  of  1569  (q.v.),  under  her  Act 
•of  Uniformity.  The  1662  Act  of  Uniformity 
did  not  retaliate  on  the  Puritans,  who  had 
ejected  bishops  and  clergy  without  mercy, 
not  twenty  years  before;  but  allowed  all 
holders  of  benefices  to  keep  them  if  they 
conformed,  and  could  get  ordained  by  bishops 
"  before  next  Bartholomew's  day,"  and  the 
result  was,  that  only  2000  out  of  many 
times  that  number  seceded.  The  modern 
Dissenters  think  they  can  never  say  too 
much  about  that,  taking  care  always  to 
iorget  that  all  those  and  many  more  of  the 
Puritan  incumbents  were  mere  intruders. 


QUAKERS 


631 


and  usurpers  of  the  places  and  property  of 
the  clergy.  After  the  Eestoration  we  hear 
no  more  of  the  Puritans  by  that  name,  and 
they  are  now  represented  by  the  multitude 
of  sects  of  Protestant  dissenters,  who  seem 
to  have  above  200  designations,  accordino-  to 
pubUshed  statistics. — Green's  Short  History ; 
Neal's  Hist,  of  Puritans ;  Hook's  Arch- 
bisJiops,  vi.  153 :  x.  71,  &c. ;  Puller's  Church 
Eist.  iii.  490,  &c.';  Wldtalcer's  Almanack, 
1886  (See  Refornuition;  Metliodists;  Prayer 
Book).    [P.H.] 

PYX  (Gk.  irv^ls,  a  box,  generally  of  box- 
wood :  Lat.  pyxis).  The  box  in  which  the 
Host  is  reserved  after  consecration.  It  was 
first  used  to  hold  the  consecrated  bread  that 
was  kept  for  the  viaticum.     "  Super  Altare 

nihil  ponetur  nisi pyxis  cum 

Corpore  Domini  ad  viaticum  pro  infirmis " 
(Leo  IV.  c.  A.D.  850;  Labbe  and  Mansi, 
Cone).  The  pyx  is  mentioned  in  the 
Council  of  York,  1179,  and  enjoined  by 
Pope  Innocent  III.  in  1215,  to  be  over  or 
near  an  altar.  Bishop  Bleys  of  Worcester, 
c.  1220,  ordered  two  pyxes,  one  of  rich 
material  for  the  Host,  and  the  other,  decent 
and  honest,  for  the  oblates.  The  arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury  in  1322  required  the 
pyx  to  be  made  of  silver  or  ivory.  Some- 
times the  pyx  was  of  the  shape  of  a  dove  ; 
but  there  are  only  two  notices  of  such  in 
England — one  in  an  inventory  of  Salisbury, 
the  other  in  Matthew  Paris.  There  are  fine 
examples  of  cup-shaped  pyxes  at  New  and 
Corpus  Christi  Colleges,  and  in  the  Bodleian, 
Oxford.— Walcott's  Sac.  Arch.  489.  It  is 
worth  mentioning  that  the  same  term  is 
used  for  the  box  of  specimens  of  new  coinage 
issued  from  time  to  time,  when  the  trial  of 
the  pyx  takes  place  before  the  Lord  Chan- 
cellor with  some  of  the  Goldsmiths'  Company 
as  his  assessors.     [H.] 


Q 

■"  QUADRAGESIMA.  The  Latin  name 
for  Lent.  It  was  formerly  given  to  the 
first  Sunday  in  Lent,  from  the  fact  of  its 
being  forty  days  before  Easter,  in  round 
numbers. 

QUAKERS.  A  society  which  originated 
with  George  Fox,  about  a.d.  1648 ;  it  is 
also  called  the  Society  of  Friends. 

I.  History. — The  name  is  supposed  to  have 
been  given  to  them  first  by  Gervase  Bennet, 
a  justice  of  the  peace  in  Derbyshire,  before 
whom  Pox  had  to  appear  for  brawling. 
Fox  warned  the  magistrate  that  he  would 
soon  "  quake  for  fear " ;  and  when  he  was 
called  in  derision  a  "  Quaker,"  he  replied 
that  there  would  be  "  Quakers  in  England 
when  justices  were  forgotten."    But   the 


632 


QUAEEES 


idea  of  persons'  bodies  trembling  and 
quaking  before  tbey  were  inspired  to  speak 
on  religious  subjects  was  very  common 
among  the  Puritans.  James  Naylor,  in  his 
Power  and  Glory  of  the  Lord  shining  out 
of  the  North,  quotes  many  passages  of 
Scripture  to  this  effect,  and  comes  to  the 
conclusion  that  "  saints  ov^ht  to  be 
Quakers."  This  Naylor  was  a  mad  fanatic, 
and  allowed  himself  to  be  called  "the 
Everlasting  Son,  the  Prince  of  Peace.''  To 
such  extremes  he  went  that  he  was  re- 
pudiated by  Fox  and  his  friends.  Yet  to 
him  Baxter  attributes  the  origin  of  the  sect, 
and  does  not  even  mention  Fox  (Baxter's 
Life  and  Times,  i.  76).  Fox  was  an 
illiterate  man,  the  son  of  a  Leicestershire 
weaver,  himself  a  cobbler.  He  wandered 
about  the  country,  haranguing  all  who 
would  listen  to  him,  forcing  his  way  into 
churches,  and  interrupting  the  services  by 
his  wild  denunciations.  For  this  he  was 
imprisoned  several  times ;  and  his  followers, 
who  went  still  further,  subjected  themselves 
to  much  persecution,  even  at  the  hands  of 
the  Puritans.  Between  1651-1657  more 
than  1900  were  imprisoned ;  in  the 
latter  year  there  were  140  in  durance.  At 
the  Restoration  the  Quakers  were  released, 
but  they  soon  laid  themselves  open  to  the 
law.  An  Act  was  passed  in  1662  against 
them  for  refusing  to  take  lawful  oaths ;  and 
this  was  followed  by  another  prohibiting 
their  assembling  for  public  worship,  under  a 
penalty  of  £5,  and  for  the  third  offence 
transportation  (14  Car.  II.  1).  Many 
persons  were  transported  to  Barbadoes  and 
Jamaica,  and  sold  as  slaves  to  the  colonists 
for  different  periods  of  time.  It  is  to 
William  Penn,  a  man  of  culture  and 
education,  that  the  Quakers  owe  that 
character  of  sobriety  and  simplicity  which 
has  ever  since  been  accorded  to  them. 
With  him  were  associated  Keith  and 
Barclay ;  and  from  that  time  there  were  no 
more  disturbances  and  brawlings  on  the  part 
of  the  Quakers ;  and  if  they  were  persecuted, 
it  was  partly  in  common  with  other  sects, 
and  partly  because  they  persistently  refused 
to  take  oaths,  or  to  show  any  of  the  usual 
marks  of  respect  to  those  in  high  oflSce  or 
dignity. 

In  America  the  Quakers,  who  appeared 
there  first  in  1656,  were  treated  with 
great  severity,  chiefly  at  the  instigation  of 
the  Puritans  of  New  England — the  Pilgi-im 
Fathers.  According  to  an  Act  of  the 
General  Court  of  Boston,  they  were  to  be 
whipped,  imprisoned,  exiled ;  and  if  they 
returned,  to  be  put  to  death.  But  a  harbour 
of  refuge  was  found  for  them.  Penn,  having 
received  a  large  grant  of  land  in  payment 
for  certain  money  he  had  lent  to  the  Crown, 
on  the  West  of  the  Delaware,  sailed  there 


QUAKERS 

with  a  large  body  of  colonists  in  1682,  and 
founded  the  city  of  Philadelphia,  which 
became  the  head  of  a  state  called  after  him 
(though  contrary  to  his  wishes),  Penn- 
sylvania. So  wisely  did  he  manage  matters 
that  there  was  no  conflict  with  the  Indians, 
as  was  the  case  in  everj'  other  instance  of 
the  founding  a  colony.  Penn  drew  up  an 
excellent  code  of  laws  for  his  state,  allowing 
full  toleration,  but  requiring  that  all  officials 
should  be  believer's  in  Jesus,  and  of  moral 
character.  The  society  has  always  flourished 
better  in  America  than  in  England,  where 
the  numbers  have  greatly  decreased.  In 
1876  it  was  stated  at  the  yearly  meetings 
that  there  was  at  last  some  advance ;  and 
since  then  there  has  been  considerable 
energy  displayed,  especially  with  regard  to 
the  establishment  of  what  are  called  "mis- 
sion meetings,"  for  those  who  are  un- 
connected with  the  body.  But,  neverthe- 
less, the  numbers  have  decreased;  and 
according  to  the  last  annual  statistical 
report  (June  10,  1886),  there  are  only- 
15,000  members,  less  than  half  the  total 
recorded  at  the  beginning  of  the  centuiy.. 
Small  communities  are  to  be  found  in- 
France,  Germany,  Norway,  and  Australia. 

II.  Discipline. — The  whole  community  of 
Friends  is  modelled  somewhat  on  the 
Presbyterian  system.  Three  gradations  of 
meetings  or  synods — monthly,  qiiarterly,- 
and  yearly — administer  the  affairs  of  the- 
Sooiety,  including  in  their  supervision 
matters  both  of  spiritual  discipline  and 
secular  polity.  The  annual  meeting  is  held 
in  London  on  the  Wednesday  after  tho 
third  Sunday  in  May,  and  remains  sitting 
many  days.  It  comprehends  the  quarterly 
meetings  of  Great  Britain,  by  all  of  which, 
representatives  are  appointed  and  reports 
addressed  to  the  yearly  meeting.  Repre- 
sentatives also  attend  from  a  yearly  meeting- 
for  Ireland  held  in  Dublin.  It  likewise 
issues  annual  epistles  of  advice  and  caution, 
appoints  committees,  and  acts  as  a  court  ot 
ultimate  appeal  from  quarterly  and  monthly 
meetings. 

A  similar  series  of  meetings,  under  regu- 
lations framed  by  the  men's  yearly  meeting, 
and  contained  in  the  Book  of  Discipline,  is 
held  by  the  female  members,  whose  pro- 
ceedings are,  however,  mainly  limited  to 
mutual  edification. 

Connected  with  the  yearly  meeting  is  a 
meeting  for  sufferings,  composed  of  ministers,, 
elders,  and  members  chosen  by  the  quarterly 
meetings.  Its  original  object  was  to  prevail 
upon  the  Government  to  grant  relief  from, 
the  many  injuries  to  which  the  early 
Friends  were  constantly  exposed.  It  has 
gradually  had  the  sphere  of  its  operations 
extended,  and  is  now  a  standing  committee' 
representing  the  yearly  meeting  during  its 


QUAKERS 

recess,  and  attending  generally  to  all  such 
matters  as  affect  the  welfare  of  the  body. 

There  are  also  meetings  of  preachers  and 
elders  for  the  purpose  of  mutual  consultation 
and  advice,  and  the  preservation  of  a  pure 
and  orthodox  ministry. 

In  case  of  disputes  among  Friends,  they 
are  not  to  appeal  to  the  ordinary  courts  of 
law,  but  to  submit  the  matter  to  the  arbi- 
tration of  two  or  more  of  their  fellow- 
members.  If  either  party  refuses  to  obey 
the  award,  the  Monthly  Meeting  to  which 
he  belongs  may  proceed  to  expel  him  from 
the  Society. 

From  the  period  of  the  Eevolution  of 
1688  the  Friends  have  received  the  benefits 
of  the  Toleration  Act.  By  the  statutes  of 
7  &  8  Wm.  III.  c.  34,  and  3  &  4  Wm.  IV. 
c.  49,  their  solemn  affirmations  are  accepted 
in  heu  of  oaths ;  and  the  abrogation  of  the 
Test  Act  renders  them  eligible  for  public 
offices. 

In  1858  it  was  agreed  that  mixed 
marriages  should  be  permitted,  and  many 
of  the  old  peculiarities  in  speech  and 
costume  (e.g.  the  use  of  the  pronouns 
"  thou  "  and  "  thee  "  instead  of  "  you  " ;  the 
scuttle-shaped  bonnet,  and  broad-brimmed 
hat)  were  abandoned. 

III.  Doctrine. — The  chief  points  have 
been  stated  by  Robert  Barclay,  one  of  the 
most  learned  of  their  persuasion,  in  his 
Apology  for  Qvakers. 

Every  one  who  leads  a  moral  life,  and 
from  the  sincerity  of  his  heart  complies 
with  the  duties  of  natural  religion,  must 
be  deemed  an  essentially  good  Christian. 
An  historical  faith  and  belief  of  some  ex- 
traordinary facts,  which  the  Christians  own 
for  truths,  are  the  only  real  difference  be- 
tween a  virtuous  Pagan  and  a  good  Chris- 
tian, and  this  faith  is  not  necessary  to  sal- 
vation. In  his  second  proposition  he  affirms, 
that  the  light  within,  or  the  Divine  inward 
revelation,  is,  like  common  principles,  self- 
evident  ;  and  therefore  it  is  not  to  be  sub- 
jected either  to  the  examination  of  the  out- 
ward testimony  of  the  Scriptures,  or  of  the 
natural  reason  of  man.  In  his  third  pro- 
position he  asserts,  that  the  Scriptures  are 
not  the  principal  ground  of  all  truth,  nor 
the  primary  rule  of  faith  and  manners,  they 
being  only  a  secondary  rule  and  subordinate 
to  the  Spirit ;  by  the  inward  testimony  of 
which  Spirit,  we  do  alone  know  them :  so 
that,  by  this  reasoning,  the  authority  of  the 
Scriptures  must  depend  upon  the  inward 
testimony  of  the  Spirit.  He  affirms  further, 
that  the  depraved  seed  of  original  sin  is  not 
imputed  to  infants  before  actual  transgres- 
sion (Prop.  4).  Those  who  have  the  gift 
of  the  light  within,  are  sufficiently  ordained 
to  preach  the  Gospel,  though  without  any 
commission  from  churches,  or  any  assist- 


QUAKERS 


C35 


anoes  from  human  learning  ;  whereas  those 
who  want  the  authority  of  this  Divine  gift, 
how  well  qualified  soever  in  other  respects, 
are  to  be  looked  upon  as  deceivers,  and  not 
true  ministers  of  the  Gospel  (Prop.  10). 
All  acceptable  worship  must  be  undertaken 
and  performed  by  the  immediate  moving  of 
the  Holy  Spirit,  which  is  neither  limited  to 
places,  times,  nor  persons ;  and  therefore 
all  outward  significations  of  Divine  worship, 
unmoved  by  secret  inspiration,  which  man 
sets  about  in  his  own  will,  and  can  both 
begin  and  end  at  his  pleasure,  all  acts  of 
worship  thus  misqualified,  consisting  either 
in  prayers,  praises,  or  preaching,  prescribed, 
premeditated,  or  extempore,  are  no  better 
than  superstitious,  will-worship  and  ab- 
ominable idolatry  in  the  sight  of  God 
(Prop.  11).  The  dominion  of  conscience 
belongs  only  to  God ;  therefore  it  is  not 
lawful  for  civil  magistrates  to  punish  their 
subjects,  either  in  fortune,  liberty,  or  per- 
son, upon  the  score  of  difference  in  worship 
or  opinions :  provided  always  that  no  man, 
under  pretence  of  conscience,  does  any 
injury  to  his  neighbour,  relating  either  to 
life  or  estate.  Women  may  preach  with  as 
much  authority  as  men,  and  be  ministers  of 
the  Church;  for  in  Christ  there  is  no 
distinction  of  male  and  female,  and  the 
prophet  Joel  has  foretold  that  women 
should  have  the  gift  of  prophecy  as  well  as- 
men. 

The  Quakers  always  held  that  outward 
baptism  is  not  an  ordinance  of  Christ,  or  at 
least  not  to  be  observed  as  a  perpetual  law. 
Whoever  pretends  that  Christ's  order  is  to 
be  understood  of  water-baptism  adds  to  the 
text,  which  does  not  mention  water.  The 
baptism  enjoined  by  Christ  is  a  baptism  of 
spirit,  not  of  water.  The  water-baptism 
was  St.  John's,  and  has  been  abolished. 
St.  Paul  says  he  was  not  sent  to  baptize, 
but  to  preach.  Water-baptism  was  used 
by  the  apostles  only  as  a  toleration  for  the 
weakness  of  the  Jews,  but  it  can  do  no 
good  to  the  soul.  Baptism  by  inspersion  is 
nowhere  mentioned  in  Scripture.  Water- 
baptism,  and  the  spiritual  baptism,  are 
two  entirely  different  baptisms.  The  in- 
ward baptism  alone  is  the  true  baptism  of 
Christ. 

Children  ought  not  to  be  baptized,  since- 
they  are  not  capable  of  taking  any  engage- 
ment upon  themselves,  or  of  making  a 
profession  of  faith,  or  of  answering  to  God 
according  to  the  testimony  of  a  good  con- 
science. 

Taking  or  receiving  the  Eucharist  is  not 
a  perpetual  obligation ;  it  was  instituted 
heretofore  only  for  those  who  were  newly 
converted  to  the  Christian  religion,  or  for 
weak  Christians  in  the  beginning  of  their 
Christianity.     The    Quakers    are    charged 


«34 


QUAEE  IMPEDIT 


•with  other  errors  of  a  very  had  complexion 
drawn  especially  from  the  writings  of  those 
who  were  first  of  their  persuasion;  but 
these  tenets  the  modern  Quakers  seem  to 
disown,  and  appear  very  willing  to  explain 
and  reconcile  their  authors  to  a  more  ortho- 
dox meaning — the  truth  is,  they  now  far 
differ  from  what  they  were  originally,  not 
•only  in  principle,  hut  even  their  external 
■demureness  and  rigidity  seem  to  he  abated. 
A  large  proijortion  of  their  Society  consists 
•of  remarkably  intellectual,  and  well-educated 
persons. — Stuhbs'  Mosheim,  iii.  433-446; 
■Jewell's  Hist,  of  Quakers ;  Neal,  Hist.  Pur. 
voL  iv. ;  Gough's  Hist.  Quakers ;  Eegistrar- 
Oeneral's  Report,  1854,  &c.    [H.] 

QUAKE  IMPEDIT,  is  a  common  law 
writ  which  lies  where  one  has  an  advowson 
and  the  parson  dies,  and  another  presents  a 
<;lerk,  or  disturbs  the  rightful  patron  in  his 
right  to  present.  It  may  he  brought  against 
both  the  bishop  and  the  alleged  disturber  of 
the  patronage,  and  the  bishop  then  appears 
■only  formally,  unless  he  claims  the  patron- 
age himself.  If  he  does,  on  the  ground  of 
'unfitness  of  the  presentee,  he  must  show 
the  cause  specifically,  so  as  to  enable  the 
Court  to  judge  of  it.  Thus,  it  seems  by 
modern  decisions,  though  not  by  old  ones, 
that  it  will  not  do  merely  to  allege  want  of 
learning;  for  a  bishop  might  capriciously 
insist  on  knowledge  of  Hebrew,  or  some 
other  unusual  and  unnecessary  learning. 
But  no  Court  has  yet  said  that  it  will  try 
the  degree  of  knowledge,  as  of  Latin  or  of 
Scripture,  which  a  presentee  has ;  and  Lord 
Ellenborough  said  very  strongly  in  Povah's 
Case  (15  East,  17)  that  he  would  not.  It  is 
said  that  if  the  cause  of  refusal  be  spiritual, 
the  Court  shall  write  to  the  Metropolitan  to 
•certify  thereof;  hut  if  the  cause  be  tem- 
poral (as  in  any  question  of  title  to  the 
presentation),  the  temporal  Court  shall  de- 
cide, and  issue  may  be  joined  thereon  and 
tried  by  a  jury. — 2  Inst.  631 ;  5  Co.  58  ;  and 
see  Bishop  of  Exeter  v.  Marshall,  L.  R. 

1  H.  L.  17 ;  and  Willis  v.  Bishop  of  Oxford, 

2  P.  Div.  192,  on  a  duplex  querela  in  the 
Court  of  Arches. 

QUARB  INCUMBRAVIT,  is  a  writ 
which  lies  where  two  are  in  plea  for  the 
.advowson  of  a  church,  and  the  bishop  ad- 
mits the  clerk  of  one  of  them  within  the 
«ix  months ;  then  the  other  shall  have  this 
writ  against  the  bishop. 

QUA  RE  NGN  ADMISIT,  is  a  writ 
which  lies  where  a  man  has  recovered  an 
advowson,  and  sends  his  clerk  to  the  bishop 
to  be  admitted,  and  the  bishop  will  not  re- 
ceive him. 

QUARREL  (from  W.  ^luarel,  a  javelin) 
and  QUARRY  (Pr.  carre),  a  diamond- 
shaped  pane  of  glass,  from  the  shape  of  a 
javelin  head. 


QUEEN  ANNE'S  BOUNTY 

QUATRODECIMANI,  or  PASCHITES. 
A  name  given,  in  the  second  century,  to  the 
Asiatic  Christians,  who  would  celebrate  the 
feast  of  Easter  on  the  third  day  after  the 
Jewish  Passover,  the  fourteenth  day  of  the 
month  Nisan,  on  what  day  of  the  week 
soever  it  happened.  The  Eastern  or  Asiatic 
rule  was  professedly  based  upon  the  au- 
thority of  SS.  John  and  Philip;  the 
Western,  i.e.  holding  the  feast  on  the  first 
Lord^s  Day  after  the  14th  of  Nisan,  upon 
that  of  SS.  Peter  and  Paul  (Soc.  H.  E. 
V.  22 ;  Euseb.  v.  23).  St.  Polycarp  had  a 
conference  with  Anioetus,  bishop  of  Rome, 
in  A.D.  158,  on  this  subject,  but  they  came 
to  no  agreement.  But  though  he  remained 
firm  in  upholding  the  Eastern  or  Quatro- 
deciman  practice,  in  a  spirit  of  Christian 
charity,  St.  Polycarp  consecrated  the  Holy 
Eucharist  in  Anicetus's  Church  on  the 
Western  Easter  (Euseb.  H.  E.  v.  24).  But 
the  controversy  soon  became  embittered,  and 
40  years  later,  Victor,  bishop  of  Rome,  ex- 
communicated all  Christians  who  did  not 
conform  to  the  Western  custom.  His  con- 
duct, however,  was  not  approved  by  other 
Churches;  and  Irenseus,  bishop  of  Lyons, 
wrote  to  expostulate  with  him.  The  Coun- 
cil of  Aries  (a.d.  314)  directed  that  Easter 
should  everywhere  be  celebrated  on  the 
same  day;  that  of  Nicsea,  that  the  day 
should  always  be  the  Lord's  Day.  The 
Church  of  Alexandria  was  to  determine  year 
by  year  which  Sunday  was  to  be  observed. 
The  British  Church  was  not  Quatrodeoiman, 
but  followed  a  different  method  of  calcu- 
lating Easter  from  that  which  was  adopted 
in  587  by  the  Roman  Church.  St.  Augus- 
tine, of  course,  followed  the  latter,  and  this 
was  one  of  the  reasons  why  the  remnant  of 
the  old  British  Church  would  not  submit  to 
him  (See  Hook's  Archbishops,  i.  14).     [H.] 

QUEEN  ANNE'S  BOUNTY.  This  in- 
stitution is  well  known  by  name,  and  for 
its  general  functions,'  of  improving  small) 
livings  by  meeting  private  benefactions  to 
them,  lending  money  for  building  on  mort- 
gages to  be  paid  off  by  thirty  equal  pay- 
ments; and  now  for  dilapidations  and  for 
insuring  parsonages,  under  the  Dilapidation 
Acts  of  1870  and  1871  (See  Dilapida- 
tions). But  very  little  is  known,  or  easily 
discoverable,  of  the  fuU  amount  of  its  work 
and  of  the  extent  which  it  has  reached 
through  good  management  from  very  small 
beginnings.  The  mere  Acts  of  Parliament 
and  charters  of  the  corporation  which  may 
be  found  in  law  books,  give  no  such  in- 
formation ;  and  the  annual  reports  quoted 
by  Parliament  contain  too  much  of  detailed 
accounts  and  too  little  in  the  way  of 
historical  summary,  to  be  easily  intelligible ; 
and  the  report  of  a  parliamentary  committee 
on  it  in  1868  is  equally  deficient  in  that 


QUEEN  ANNE'S  BOUNTY 

respect.  The  late  Christoplier  Hodgson, 
who  was  the  secretary  and  principal  officer 
•of  the  corporation  for  nearly  half  a  century, 
published  an  Account  of  Queen  Anne's 
Bounty  in  1848,  with  a  supplement  in  1864, 
which  should  be  read  by  those  who  wish  to 
understand  its  history  up  to  that  time.  We 
can  only  give  a  very  short  summary  of  it ; 
and  for  business  purposes  the  clergy  or 
persons  wishing  to  augment  livings  wUl,  of 
course,  communicate  with  the  Secretary  of 
the  ofSce  in  Dean's  Yard,  Westminster. 

It  originated  with  the  papal  usurpation 
in  King  John's  time,  of  the  first  fruits  and 
tenths  of  aU  benefices.  They  were  trans- 
ferred to  the  Crown  by  one  of  the  early 
Reformation  Acts,  26  Hen.  VIII.  c.  3,  who, 
of  course,  kept  or  them,  rather  charged  them 
with  grants  to  courtiers,  as  he  did  the 
spoils  of  the  abbeys.  Bishop  Burnet,  in  his 
History  of  his  own  Time,  relates  that  he 
had  persuaded  Mary  II.  to  give  them  back 
to  the  Church,  but  the  design  was  stopped 
by  her  death,  and  again  by  that  of  William 
III.,  who  had  consented.  It  was  proposed 
to  Parliament  b.y  Queen  Anne;  and  the 
Act  2  &  3  Anne,  c.  11,  was  passed,  enabling 
her  to  found  the  corporation,  and  make 
rules  for  it  by  Eoyal  Charter  or  Letters 
Patent,  which  has  been  done  from  time  to 
time.  The  charters  are  given  in  Mr. 
Hodgson's  book.  The  first  fruits  and  tenths 
were  then  and  still  are  levied  on  the  old 
valuation  in  the  king's  books,  of  Henry. 
VIIL,  except  that  those  on  the  incomes  of 
the  bishops  and  the  "  suspended  "  canonries 
have  been  adjusted  since  they  passed  into 
the  hands  of  the  Ecclesiastical  Commission. 
The  total  amount  is,  and  always  has  been, 
about  £14,000  a  year,  levied  on  about  4,500 
benefices;  all  those  under  £50  in  value 
having  been  discharged  by  5  &  6  Aime,  c.  24. 
The  incumbrances  above  mentioned  made 
that  small  income  stiU  smaller  at  first,  but 
they  were  gradually  got  rid  of.  Moreover, 
Parliament  granted  £100,000  for  eleven 
years  from  1809.  From  this  comparatively 
•small  origin  it  has  now  reached  the  capital 
amount  of  4i  millions,  and  an  annual 
income  of  about  £167,000 ;  and,  according  to 
the  appendix,  to  the  report  of  1868,  poor 
benefices  had  been  up  to  that  time  aug- 
mented by  no  less  than  £5,790,935  through 
the  agency  of  Queen  Anne's  Bounty,  and 
the  benefactions  it  has  obtained,  which  were 
stated  to  have  then  amounted  to  £2,144,180. 
The  later  accounts  do  not  show  how  much 
more  they  have  reached,  but  they  seem 
generally  to  exceed  £25,000  a  year;  and 
the  annual  amount  paid  to  the  clergy,  apart 
from  loans  for  building,  seems  to  be  about 
£167,000. 

Both  the  late  and  present  treasm-ers  attri- 
Sjute  these  great  results  to  the  principles  on 


QUESTMEN 


635 


which  the  fund  has  always  been  managed, 
viz. — (1)  according  to  the  charter  making 
all  its  grants  out  of  the  primary  fund  by 
way  of  gift,  and  not  by  annuities  ;  and  (2) 
by  requiring  benefactions  to  meet  their 
gifts,  which  several  of  the  bishops  said 
there  has  never  been  any  difficulty  in 
getting  hitherto,  esiMcially  as  Queen  Anne's 
Bounty  never  makes  gi-ants  to  benefices  over 
£200  a  year  in  value,  and  no  single  grant 
exceeds  £200,  but  they  may  be  repeated.  It 
acts  as  a  trustee  for  any  benefactions  of  either 
real  or  personal  property  of  any  kind  which 
benefactors  may  wish  to  give  to  livings  of 
any  value,  for  which  they  soraetijnes  do  not 
know  how  to  make  such  gifts.  It  also  aids 
clergymen  to  buy  small  pieces  of  land  near 
their  own,  or  to  annex  them  to  the  living 
where  they  have  bought  them  privately  and 
cannot  aifoi-d  to  give  them.  It  should  be 
mentioned  that,  by  43  Geo.  HI.  c.  107,  gifts 
of  land  to  Queen  Anne's  Bounty  by  either 
deed  or  wiU  for  the  augmentation  of  benefices 
are  exempted  from  the  Mortmain  Acts,  which 
is  a  very  important  and  well-known  provi- 
sion. And  by  several  Acts  arrangements  for 
transferring  patronage  to  benefactors  are 
authorised.  It  is  incidentally  stated  in  the 
report  of  the  committee  of  1868  that  the 
average  duration  of  incumbencies  appears 
to  be  about  twenty-one  years.  Tliat  com- 
mittee, after  inquiring  carefully  into  the 
proportion  of  the  working  expenses  of 
Queen  Anne's  Bounty  compared  with  that 
of  the  Ecclesiastical  Commission,  both  from 
the  treasurer  aiad  several  bishops  who  were 
active  members  of  both  bodies,  reported 
against  their  amalgamation,  which  had 
been  suggested ;  and  partlj'',  but  not  entirely, 
on  the  ground  that  the  working  percentage 
of  Queen  Anne's  Bounty  is  very  much 
smaller  than  that  of  the  Ecclesiastical  Com- 
mission, though  no  doubt  the  work  of  the 
latter,  involving  management  of  large  estates, 
is  of  a  more  costly  kind.  Still  the  difference 
seems  very  great,  on  any  mode  of  reckoning, 
and  the  success  of  the  management  of  Queen 
Anne's  Bounty  is  the  best  answer  to  any 
theoretical  proposals  to  remove  it.      [G-.  ] 

QUEEN'S  MAJESTY,  PEAYEE  FOE. 
This  is  first  found  in  two  little  volumes  of 
"Private  Prayers,"  published  in  1547.  It 
was  inserted  in  the  Prj'mer  in  1553,  and, 
somewhat  altered  and  shortened,  in  the 
Prayer  Book  of  1569,  when  it  was  used  in 
the  Litany  before  the  prayer  of  St.  Chry- 
sostom.  In  1661  it  was  placed  iu  its 
present  position  in  Morning  and  Evening 
Service.  The  Collects  for  the  King  (or 
Queen)  in  the  Holy  Communion  Service 
were  both  composed  in  1549.      [H.] 

QUEEISTEE,  or  QUIEISTEE.  The 
same  as  Chorister,  which  see. 

QUESTMEN.       Persons    appointed    to 


636 


QUIETISTS 


lielp  the  cliurohivardens.  In  the  ancient 
episcopal  synods,  the  bishops  were  wont  to 
summon  divers  men  out  of  each  parish  to 
give  information  of  the  disorders  of  the 
clergy  and  people,  and  these  in  process  of 
time  became  standing  ofiScers,  called  synod's 
men,  sidesmen,  or  questmen.  The  whole 
of  the  oflBce  of  these  persons  seems  by  cus- 
tom to  have  devolved  on  the  churchwardens 
(See  Churchwardens). 

QUIETISTS.  A  Christian  sect,  that 
took  its  origin  in  the  seventeenth  century 
from  Michael  Molinos,  a  Spanish  priest, 
who  endeavoured  to  establish  new  doctrines 
in  Italy ;  the  chief  of  which  was,  that  men 
ought  to  annihilate  themselves,  in  order  to 
be  united  to  God,  and  remain  afterwards  in 
quietness  of  mind,  without  being  troubled 
for  what  should  happen  to  the  body ;  and 
therefore  his  followers  took  the  name  of 
Quietists,  from  the  word  qiiies,  rest.  By 
that  principle  he  pretended  that  no  real  act 
was  either  meritorious  or  criminal,  because 
the  soul  and  its  faculties,  being  annihilated, 
had  no  part  therein ;  and  so  this  doctrine 
led  people  to  transgress  all  laws,  sacred  and 
civil.  The  doctrine  of  Molinos  in  1687  was 
by  the  inquisitors  and  pope  declared  false 
and  pernicious,  and  his  book  burnt.  He 
himself  was  imprisoned  after  he  had  re- 
canted, and  died  in  1692.  It  is  supposed 
there  long  remained  many  of  this  sect. 
Their  doctrine  also  crept  over  the  Alps  into 
Prance ;  the  "  Maxims  of  the  Saints  ex- 
plained," written  by  P&elon,  archbishop 
of  Cambray,  having  some  tendency  that 
way,  and  having  been  therefore  condemned 
by  the  pope  in  1699. — Stubbs'  Mosheim,  iii. 
288 

QUINQUAGESIMA.  The  Sunday  be- 
fore Lent,  so  called  because  it  is  ihe:  fiftieth 
day  before  Easter,  reckoned  in  the  whole 
numbers. 

QU I NQU  ARTICULAR  CONTRO- 

VERSY. The  controversy  between  the 
Arminians  and  the  Calvinists  on  the  Five 
Points  (See  Five  Points'). 

QUIRE  (See  Qhoir). 

QUOD  PERMITTAT,  is  a  writ  granted 
to  the  successor  of  a  parson,  for  the  recovery 
of  pasture,  by  the  statute  of  the  13  Edw.  I. 
C.24. 


R. 

RAILS,  ALTAR,  were  introduced  by 
Bishop  Andrewes,  who  calls  them  "wain- 
scot bannisters,"  and  Archbishop  Laud,  to 
protect  the  altar  from  profanation.  "At 
Taplow,"  wrote  Laud  to  the  King,  "  there 
happened  a  very  ill  accident  by  reason  of 
not  having  the  Communion-table  railed  in, 


RATIONALISM 

that  it  might  be  kept  from  profanations. 
For  in  the  sermon-time  a  dog  came  to  the 
table  and  took  the  loaf  of  bread  prepared  for 
the  Holy  Sacrament." — Hook's  Archbishops, 
si.  244  (See  Altar  Rails).     [H.] 

RANTERS.  An  Antinomian  denomina- 
tion which  arose  about  the  year  1645.  They 
set  up  the  light  of  nature  under  the  name 
of  Christ  in  men,  and  practised  all  sorts  of 
lewdness  and  profanity.  With  regard  to 
the  Church,  Scripture,  ministry,  &c.,  their 
sentiments  were  the  same  as  the  Familists 
(Puller's  ai.  Hist.  iii.  211,  ed.  1837).  The 
sect  thus  instituted  is  now  extinct,  and  the- 
name  is  given  to  the  "Primitive  Metho- 
dists," as  a  branch  of  the  Methodists  are 
denominated. 

RATES  (See  aiurch  Rates). 

RATIONALISM.  Inasmuch  as  every- 
body professes  and  believes  himself  to  be 
rational,  and  not  to  have  any  views  about 
religion  but  what  are  founded  on  good 
reasons,  it  is  evident  that  "  rationalist "  is  a 
mere  conventional  epithet,  originally  as- 
sumed by  persons  who  pretended  to  be  more 
reasonable  than  others.  And  as  they  were 
infidels  or  atheists  in  various  degrees,  the 
eame  epithet  came  to  be  applied  to  infidels- 
and  atheists  in  general,  though  they  are  of 
course  considered  most  irrational  by  be- 
lievers in  God  and  in  any  form  of  Christianity. 
It  is  therefore  useless  to  inquire  whether 
any  particular  anti-christian  writer  or  school 
called  themselves  or  their  system  of  philoso- 
phy rationalistic,  or  were  called  so  by  others- 
at  the  time.  And  a  history  of  rationalism 
(in  this  usual  sense)  is  necessarily  a  history 
of  those  who  have  argued  against  what  is 
always  meant  by  the  word  religion  by  all 
mankind,  except  a  few  cunning  -writers 
who  first  say  that  they  mean  something 
else  by  it  and  then  always  slide  back  into 
the  common  use  as  soon  as  it  suits  them  : 
which  is  a  very  common  trick  of  modern 
rationalistic  controversy.  It  would  require 
much  more  space  than  we  can  give  to  it  to- 
attempt  even  an  abstract  of  the  many- 
rationalistic  systems  which  have  been  in- 
vented from  the  days  of  the  Gnostics  till 
the  present  time.  A  full  account  of  them 
all  up  to  1862  was  given  in  the  Bampton 
Lectures  of  Canon  A.  S.  (not  P.  W.)  Parrar 
in  that  year.  About  the  same  time  appeared 
the  once  famous  Essays  and  Reviews,  of 
which  several  were  more  or  less  oj)posed  to 
Christianity..  They  gave  rise  to  two  volumes  ; 
one  of  directly  controversial  Ansioers,  and 
another  less  directly  controversial  and  of 
more  permanent  value,  called  Aids  to  Faith  ; 
and  also  to  the  great  undertaking  called  the 
Speaker's  Commentary  on  the  Bible,  by 
many  eminent  theologians,  edited  by  Canon 
F.  0.  Cook,  preacher  of  Lincoln's  Inn.  Ex- 
cept for  the  litigation  which  declared  the 


KATIONALISM 

lawfulness  of  publishing  doubts  about  the 
eternity  of  punisliment,  probably  no  theo- 
logical or  anti-theological  book  of  such 
celebrity  for  the  time  has  more  completely 
passed  into  oblivion  than  Essays  and  He- 
views.  Much  the  same  may  be  said  of  the 
still  more  pronounced  anti-christian  work 
published  anonymously  in  1872,  in  two 
-volumes,  with  the  title  of  Supernatural 
Seligion,  of  which  several  editions  were 
quickly  sold,  as  it  made  a  vast  parade  of 
imusual  learning,  and  such  books  necessarily 
take  some  time  to  expose  thoroughly.  Verj' 
little  more  was  heard  of  it  after  the  exposure 
of  its  false  pretences  of  learning,  and  its  bad 
reasoning,  by  Bishop  Lightfoot  in  some 
articles  in  the  Contemporary  Review,  and 
by  the  Eev.  M.  F.  Sadler's  Lost  Gospel; 
both  of  which  answers  left  it  hardly  possible 
to  believe  even  in  the  honesty  of  the  author 
•of  Supernatural  Religion.  Probably  the 
most  voluminous,  and  in  a  sense,  successful 
rationalistic  author  of  the  present  day  is  Mr. 
Herbert  Spencer,  whose  works  were  said 
to  have  reached  fifteen  volumes  in  the 
Edinburgh  Review  of  his  First  Principles 
in  January,  1884,  to  which  we  referred  in 
the  article  on  Miracles.  It  is  hardly 
necessary  to  mention  the  names  of  the 
more  genuine  physical  philosophers,  such  as 
Darwin,  Huxley,  and  Tyndall,  whose  ra- 
tionalistic or  materialistic  theories  may  be 
severed  from  their  physical  discoveries  and 
philosophy,  which  would  be  equally  good 
whether  the  prime  cause  of  all  things  is  a 
creator  or  nothing  at  all ;  while  Spencer's 
philosophy  has  discovered  nothing  and  ex- 
plained nothing,  nor  increased  the  stock  of 
human  knowledge  at  all;  and  with  a  greater 
pretence  of  founding  a  complete  cosmogony 
than  any  since  Lucretius's  ingenious  non.- 
sense  (as  everybody  now  knows  it  to  be)  ends 
by  pronouncing  the  origin  of  every  separate 
force  or  law  of  nature,  of  which  the  number 
is  infinite,  "an  unfathomable  mystery," 
spontaneously  generated  out  of  what  he  is 
pleased  to  call  Persistent  Force,  which 
made  itself.  Such  rationalism  as  that  wiU 
soon  have  had  its  day,  like  its  predecessors, 
in  spite  of  any  number  of  volumes  and 
admirers  who  profess  to  understand  them, 
and  call  Spencer  a  much  greater  philosopher 
than  Newton. 

The  short  life  that  has  been  enjoyed  by 
■every  rationalistic  system  from  the  beginning 
of  the  literary  opposition  to  Christianity  (as 
-distinguished  from  heathen  persecution) 
nntil  now,  is  a  phenomenon  almost  as 
•striking  as  the  primary  and  continuous  one 
of  Christianity  itself,  which  they  all  in 
succession  seek  to  explain  away  or  to  account 
for,  by  first  one  tiling  and  then  another, 
dillerent  from  the  simple  explanation  that 
it  is  true,  i.e.  that    the    Miracles  which 


RATIONALISM 


637 


founded  it  are  true.  Some  rationalistic 
schools  or  systems  of  course  have  flourished 
rather  longer  than  others ;  but  not  one  has 
reached  either  the  position  or  the  duration 
of  a  second-rate  dissenting  sect,  and  much 
less  that  of  the  two  or  three  most  popular 
ones.  Some  of  them  have  compensated  for 
any  mischief  they  have  done  by  evoking 
Christian  "apologies"  or  defences  of 
Christianity  which  are,  without  exaggeration, 
called  immort-al,  although  even  such  works 
as  those  of  Paley  and  Butler  require  supple- 
menting from  time  to  time  to  meet  new 
physical  discoveries,  and  new  rationalistic 
arguments.  At  present  it  is  probably  right 
to  treat  Eenan  as  the  leading  foreign  an- 
tagonist of  Christianity,  while  a  few  years 
ago  it  was  Strauss,  and  some  other  Germans, 
whom  we  do  not  name,  because  if  we  began 
naming  it  would  be  diflScult  to  know  where 
to  stop,  and  names  alone  would  be  of  little 
use.  The  emptiness  of  Kenan's  reasoning, 
and  its  inconsistency  with  his  own  ad- 
missions, are  well  shown  in  a  small  tract  on 
The  Authenticity  of  the  Gospels,  by  Dr. 
AVace,  one  of  a  series  of  what  are  called 
Present  Day  Tracts,  of  which  one  sentence 
is  enough  to  quote  here :  "  Eenan  practically 
confesses  that  every  objection  (to  St.  John's 
Gospel)  is  insufficient,  except  one ;  and  that 
is,  that  in  his  opinion  the  discourses  of  our 
Lord,  as  recorded  there,  are  pretentious 
tirades,  heavy,  badly  written,  making  but 
little  appeal  to  the  moral  sense,"  which  Dr. 
Wace  truly  says  may  well  be  left  to  the 
judgment  of  any  fair  reader.  Eenan's  only 
material  objection  to  the  other  gospels  is 
that  they  record  miracles,  of  which  he  says 
"  there  is  no  experimental  trace,"  whatever 
that  means.  If  it  means  that  there  has 
been  no  subsequent  experience  of  miracles, 
it  is  only  Hume's  paradox  over  again  in  new 
words  (see  Miracles).  But  no  events  that 
were  ever  recorded  in  the  world  have  left 
such  large  experimental  traces  as  the 
Christian  miracles ;  for  the  whole  state  of 
the  world,  except  among  mere  savages,  has 
been  affected,  and  in  all  the  progressive 
nations  transformed,  by  them,  or  if  Eenan 
likes,  by  the  records  of  them,  and  the  general 
belief  in  them.  Nothing  can  be  more 
ridiculous,  or  a  more  glaring  contradiction 
of  history,  than  to  say  that  a  phenomenon 
which  has  affected  the  whole  world  more 
and  more  for  nineteen  centuries,  and  is 
daily  fulfilling  the  prophecies  that  it  would 
do  so,  is  not  the  consequence  of  the  only 
cause  that  was  ever  known  for  it,  either 
when  it  began  or  since,  or  to  talk  of  that 
cause  having  left  no  experimental  traces. 
Christianity  is  as  much  the  consequence  of 
the  Christian  miracles,  however  they  were 
done,  as  the  position  of  the  planets  is  of 
gravity,  and   some  imknown  initial  force 


638 


EATIONALISM 


acting  across  it,  whatever  may  be  the  ex- 
planation of  gravity  itself. 

It  is  singular  also  that  no  rationalistic 
system  of  even  moral  philosophy  has  ever 
been  able  to  gain  a  permanent  footing  since 
that  of  the  New  Testament  came  into  the 
world — if  any  did  before,  except  the  Mosaic. 
Mr.  Spencer  has  amused  himself  by  con- 
structing one  which  he  calls  the  Data  of 
Ethics,  as  a  benevolent  substitute  for  ex- 
piring Christianity.  The  morals  of  it  are 
generally  good  enough,  being  much  like 
those  which  he  found  ready-made  in  the 
New  Testament,  and  the  consequent  opinions 
of  the  civilized  world,  with  the  new  names 
which  he  likes  to  give  to  everything.  But 
it  would  puzzle  a  much  greater  philosopher 
than  him  to  convince  common  people  who 
see  their  advantage  in  doing  wrong,  that 
they  had  better  do  right,  without  any 
prospect  of  another  world. 

It  has  been  the  fashion  with  some  infidels 
to  set  up  the  persecuting  emperor  Marcus 
Aurelius  as  a  moral  philosopher  equal  to 
Christ,  because  he  wrote  a  boot  of  excellent 
moral  platitudes,  which  never  influenced 
any  human  being.  Some  other  modem 
rationalistic  philosophers  however,  both 
male  and  female,  have  propounded  moral 
doctrines  of  a  very  different  kind,  and  much 
more  likely  to  be  followed  by  the  common 
run  of  mankind  if  Christianity  were  really 
in  the  dying  condition  which  Mr.  Spencer 
and  his  associates  always  assume.  Others 
have  gone  so  far  as  to  say  that  the  morality 
of  the  New  Testament  is  inferior  to  some 
system  of  their  own,  and  pi-ofess  to  prove  it 
by  the  immoralities  and  cruelties  and  sins 
of  too  many  Christians,  and  especially  by 
the  religious  persecutions  sanctioned  by  the 
greatest  Christian  Church  for  ages,  which 
have  not  so  very  long  gone  out  of  fashion, 
if  they  have  yet,  except  from  impotence. 
But  such  reasoning  is  absurd,  unless  they, 
can  show  that  the  sins  which  they  denounce 
are  recommended  and  not  denounced  by  the 
New  Testament ;  and  of  course  they  cannot, 
and  never  even  try.  Another  of  their 
absurdities  is  that  of  calling  Christianity 
"  selfish,"  because  it  promises  a  future  life  of 
happiness  as  the  reward  of  virtue  and  faith 
in  this.  That  again  is  a  mere  piece  of 
verbal  trickery;  for  the  only  selfishness 
which  there  is  any  pretence  for  calling 
wrong  is  that  which  sacrifices  other  people's 
good  to  your  own,  and  no  infidel  has 
attempted  to  make  out  that  the  faith  or 
practice  of  Christianity  ever  does  that. 

It  is  another  fundamental  rationalistic 
paradox,  or  plausible  piece  of  bad  reasoning, 
to  talk  of  reason  as  opposed  to  faith,  as  if  they 
had  reason  and  we  had  faith  only.  ITaith  only 
means  belief  in  something ;  and  to  be  good 
for   anything  it  must  be  founded  on  good 


EEADEE 

reasoning.  Belief  that  the  world  was  made 
by  a  Creator  is  no  more  faith  without  reason 
than  belief  tliat  the  world  made  itself  out 
of  self-existing  atoms  uniformly  diffused 
through  space,  by  forces  which  sprang  from 
"  Persistent  Force  "  in  some  "  unfathomably 
mysterious"  way,  or  that  such  atoms  had 
in  themselves  "  self-contained  energy,"  and 
the  "  promise  and  potency  of  life,"  to  use  the 
phrases  of  some  other  eminent  rationalists. 
It  is  evidently  a  great  deal  less  so,  because 
the  moment  a  man  assigns  an  unfathomable 
mystery  as  an  explanation  of  some  physical 
process,  of  which  also  there  is  no  proof 
whatever,  he  at  once  ipso  facto  abandons 
reason  and  substitutes  faith — in  himself  or 
his  dicta.  Failh  in  revelation  only  means 
the  belief  that  the  events  recorded  in  the 
New  Testament  took  place,  for  which 
abundant  reasons  have  been  given  in  many 
books.  The  contrary  belief  is  nothing  by 
itself,  without  some  demonstrable  alterna- 
tive, now  that  Christianity  exists  almost 
universally.  It  is  no  less  absurd  than  for 
a  man  to  say  he  does  not  believe  in  some 
law  of  nature  which  cannot  be  absolutely 
proved  to  his  sight.  The  phenomena  are 
here,  and  no  rationalistic  arguing  can  get 
rid  of  them  now.  A  priori  arguments 
against  them  are  worth  nothing  vfithout 
some  alternative  suflicient  cause  of  the  phe- 
nomena. A  mere  negative  unbelief  in  the 
obvious  explanation  of  them  is  utterlj' 
um'easonable  by  itself,  and  involves  an  im- 
possibilitj'.  It  must  be  accompanied  by 
some  kind  of  positive  and  defensible  belief 
in  some  other  explanation  of  the  history 
of  the  world,  and  of  the  invention  by  the 
New  Testament  writers  of  such  a  character 
as  that  of  Jesus  Christ ;  and  if  that  alterna- 
tive belief  or  theory  cannot  be  proved  with 
at  least  as  much  probability  as  the  common 
simple  one  that  the  New  Testament  is  true, 
it  is  as  good  for  nothing  as  the  dictum 
that  the  world  made  itself  by  unfathomable 
mysteries  and  automatic  conversions  of  per- 
sistent force  in  no  particular  direction  into 
an  infinity  of  particular  forces,  and  of  homo- 
geneous self-existing  matter,  and  dividing 
itself  into  all  sorts  of  unhomogeneous  ele- 
ments, each  ■(vith  characteristics  of  its  own 
(See  Positivists).    [G.] 

READER.  The  office  of  reader  was  one 
of  the  five  inferior  orders  in  the  Church. 

It  is  said  that  readers  were  first  appointed 
in  the  Church  about  the  third  century. 
They  are  mentioned  by  Tertullian  {de  Prx- 
scrip.  c.  41)  and  by  St.  Cyprian  (Ep.  33,  al. 
38),  who  speaks  of  one  Aurelius  whom  he 
had  ordained  a  reader  for  his  singular  merits. 
In  the  Greek  Church  they  were  said  to  have 
been  ordained  by  the  imposition  of  hands : 
but  whether  this  was  the  practice  of  all  the 
Greek  Churches  has  been  much  questioned. 


EEADER 

In  the  Latin  Churcli  it  was  certainly  other- 
wise. The  Council  of  Carthage  speaks  of 
no  other  ceremony  but  the  bishop's  putting 
the  Bible  into  his  hands  in  the  presence  of 
the  people,  with  these  words,  "Take  this 
book  and  be  thou  a  reader  of  the  word  of 
God,  which  office  if  thou  shalt  faithfully 
and  profitably  perform,  thou  shalt  have  part 
with  those  that  minister  in  the  word  of 
God."  And,  in  Cyprian's  time,  they  seem 
not  to  have  had  so  much  as  this  ceremony 
of  delivering  the  Bible  to  them,  but  were 
made  readers  by  the  bishop's  commission 
and  deputation  only  to  such  a  station  in 
the  Church. — Bingham,  bk.  iii.  c.  v. 

Upon  the  Keformation  here,  they  were 
required  to  subscribe  to  the  following  in- 
junctions : — "  Imprimis, — I  shall  not  preach 
or  interpret,  but  only  read  that  which  is 
appointed  by  public  authority : — I  shall  not 
minister  the  sacraments  or  other  public  rites 
of  the  Church,   but  bury  the  dead,  and 
purify  women  after  their  child-birth : —  I 
shall  keep  the  register  book  according  to 
the  injunctions: — I  shall  use   sobriety  in 
apparel,  and  especially  in  the  churcli  at 
common  prayer: — I   shall  move    men    to 
quiet  and  concord,  and  not  give  them  cause 
of  offence : — I  shall  bring  in  to  my  ordinary, 
testimony  of  my  behaviour,  from  the  honest 
of  the  parish  where  I  dwell,  within  one  half 
year  next  following : — I   shall  give  place 
upon  convenient  warning  so  thought  by  the 
ordinary,  if  any  learned  minister  shall  be 
placed  there  at  the  suit  of  the  patron  of  the 
parish  : — I  shall  claim  no  more  of  the  fruits 
sequestered  of  such  cure  where  I  shall  serve, 
but  as  it  shall  be  thought  meet  to   the 
wisdom  of  the  ordinary : — I  shall  daily  at 
the  least  read  one  chapter  of  the  Old  Testa- 
ment, and  one  other  of  the  New,  with  good 
advisement,  to  the  increase  of  my  know- 
ledge : — I  shall  not  appoint  in  my  room,  by 
reason  of  my  absence  or  sickness,  any  other 
man ;  but  shall  leave  it  to  the  suit  of  the 
parish  to  the  ordinary,  for  assigning  some 
other  able  man: — I  shall  not  read  but  in 
poorer    parishes    destitute  of   incumbents, 
except  in  the  time  of  sickness,  or  for  other 
good  considerations  to  be  allowed  by  the 
ordinary: — I   shall  not  openly  intermeddle 
with  any  artificer's  occupations,  as  covet- 
ously to   seek  a  gain  thereby,  having  in 
ecclesiastical    living    the    sum  of   twenty 
nobles  or  above  by  the  year." 

This  was  resolved  to  be  put  to  all  readers 
and  deacons  by  the  respective  bishops,  and 
is  signed  by  both  the  archbishops,  together 
with  the  bishops  of  London,  Winchester,  Ely, 
Sarum,  Carlisle,  Chester,  Exeter,  Bath  and 
Wells,  and  Gloucester. — Strype's  Annals. 

In  churches  or  chapels  where  there  is  only 
a  very  small  endowment,  and  no  clergyman 
will  take  upon  him   the  charge  or  cure 


EEADING  IN 


es* 


thereof,  it  was  at  one  time  usual  to  admit 
readers,  to  the  end  that  Divine  service  in 
such  places  might  not  altogether  be  neg- 
lected (Burn's  Hcd.  Law,  Tit.  "  Readers  "). 
But  the  lawfulness  of  such  admission  has 
never  been  allowed,  and  it  has  long  since 
been  obsolete. 

Lay  Headers  are  now  in  several  dioceses 
admitted  and  licensed  by  the  bishop  to 
conduct  services  for  the  poor  in  school  and 
mission  rooms,  and  give  lay  assistance  in 
parochial  work. — -  Official  Year  Booh,  1885, 
p.  603 ;  1886,  p.  Ill :  see  Lay  Readers. 

EEADING  DESK.  The  reading  desk, 
or  reading  pew,  was  ordered  by  the  eighty- 
second  canon  to  be  placed  in  every  church 
not  already  provided  with  one.  The  reading, 
desk  is  only  once  recognised  in  our  Prayer 
Book,  and  that  in  the  rubric  prefixed  to  the 
Commination,  and  is  there  called  a  reading 
pew ;  and  it  is  remarkable  that  the  term, 
was  first  introduced  there  at  the  last  re- 
vision of  the  Prayer  Book,  in  1661 ;  it  is 
not  found  in  any  edition  printed  before  that 
time.  In  the  Advertisements  of  1565  it 
was  directed  "  that  the  Common  Prayer  be 
said  or  sung  decently  and  distinctly,  in  such 
place  as  the  ordinary  shall  think  meet  for 
the  largeness  and  straightness  of  the  church 
and  choir,  so  that  the  people  may  be 
edified "  (Cardw.  Docum.  Ann.\  i.  291). 
Bishop  Sparrow  tells  us  that,  previously  to 
the  time  of  Cromwell,  the  reading  pew  had 
one  desk  for  the  Bible,  looking  towards  the 
people  to  the  body  of  the  church ;  another 
for  the  Prayer  Book,  looking  towards  the 
east,  or  upper  end  of  the  chancel.  Reading 
desks  now  generally  face  north  or  south, 
and  in  man}''  churches  there  are  both ;  in 
some  large  cross  churches  it  faces  N.W.  or 
S.W.,  against  one  of  the  tower  piers,  and 
some  are  double,  for  two  ministers.  In 
Q-riffen  v.  Digliton,  0.  J.  Brie  decided  (on 
appeal  in  1864)  thkt  the  chancel  is  the 
place  appointed  for  the  clergyman  and  for 
those  who  assist  him  in  the  performance  of 
Divine  service,  and  consequently  that  he 
has  a  right  to  sit  there. 

READING  IN.  The  ceremony  of  read- 
ing in,  which  is  required  of  every  incumbent 
on  entering  upon  his  cure,  is  now  ordered 
as  follows,  under  the  Clerical  Subscription 
Act,  1865  (c.  122,  s.  7).  Every  person 
instituted  to  any  benefice  with  cure  of  souls 
shall,  on  the  first  Sunday  on  which  he 
officiates  in  the  church,  or  such  other 
Sunday  as  the  ordinary  appoints,  openly 
read  before  the  congregation  the  Thirty-nine 
Articles,  and  immediately  after  make  the 
Declaration  of  Assent  in  the  Act;  so  that 
the  whole  nms  thus :  "  I  assent  to  the  Thirty- 
nine  Articles  of  Religion  which  I  have  now 
read  before  you,  and  to  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer,   and   of   the   ordering   of  bishops. 


•640 


REAL  PRESENCE 


priests,  and  deacons.  I  believe  the  doctrine 
of  the  Church  of  England  as  therein  set 
forth  to  be  agreeable  to  the  Word  of  God ; 
and  in  public  prayer  and  administration  of 
the  Sacraments  I  will  use  the  form  in  the 
said  book  prescribed  and  no  other,  except  so 
far  as  may  be  ordered  by  lawful  authority  ?  " 
A  memorandum  to  that  effect  is  signed  by 
■the  churchwardens  or  other  inhabitants, 
and  sent  to  the  bishop,  though  that  is  not 
Actually  ordered  by  this  Act.  If  the 
■clergyman  wilfully  fails  to  read  in  ac- 
cordingly, "he  shall  absolutely  forfeit  the 
Jbenefice."  Curates  are  also  required  by  the 
Act,  s.  8,  to  sign  the  declaration  of  assent 
■on  the  first  Sunday  they  officiate — and  no 
other — ^but  not  to  read  the  Articles. 

REAL  PRESENCE.  In  deaUng  with 
this  difficult  subject  it  is  necessary  to 
■distinguish  the  different  senses  in  which 
this  expression  has  been  used. 

I.  It  has  sometimes  been  employed  as 
■equivalent  to  the  term  Corporal  Presence; 
i.e.  to  assert  the  presence  in  the  Holy 
Sacrament  of  the  Lord's  Supper  of  the  Body 
and  Blood  of  Chi-ist  in  a  corporeal  or  ma- 
terially substantive  manner.  This  definition 
of  the  mode  of  the  Presence  of  the  Lord, 
whether  taken  to  imply  the  Transuhstantia- 
tion  of  the  elements,  or  to  express  the 
modified  view  described  as  Consuhstantiation, 
the  Church  of  England  has  rejected.  This 
kind  of  Presence  has  sometimes  been  de- 
nominated JReal,  both  by  those  who  hold, 
and  by  those  who  reject,  the  definition. 
Hence  in  the  Reformation  controversies  the 
word  was  sometimes  repudiated,  when  the 
intention  was  to  repudiate  only  this  applica- 
tion of  it.  Thus  the  twenty-eighth  Article 
of  1552  condemned  the  doctrine  of  "the 
real  and  Ixidily  presence  (as  they  term  it) 
of  Christ's  Flesh  and  Blood  in  the  Sacrament 
of  the  Lord's  Supper." 

The  Corporal  Presence  thus  understood, 
to  which  some  would  improperly  confine 
the  application  of  the  word  Real,  has  been 
further  described  as  the  "  Corporal  presence 
of  Christ's  natural  Flesh  and  Blood."  This 
•expression  occurs  in  the  declaration  ap- 
pended to  our  Communion  Service;  where 
it  is  further  said  that  "  the  natural  Body 
and  Blood  of  our  Saviour  Christ  are  in 
heaven  and  not  here."  The  word  "  natural " 
thus  applied  to  our  Lord's  Body  now  in 
heaven  (with  no  reference,  clearly,  to  the 
<listinction  made  by  St.  Paul  in  1  Cor.  xv.) 
must  be  understood  to  express  the  fact  that 
our  Lord  Jesus  Christ,  Who  when  He  was 
on  earth,  possessed  a  human  Body  dis- 
tinguishing Him  from  other  men,  has  still 
in  heaven  a  human,  but  glorified.  Body 
individualising  Him  as  man.  The  virtue  of 
His  humanity,  and  so  His  humanity  itself, 
is  partaken  of  by  us ;  yet  "  the  Man  Christ 


REAL  PRESENCE 

Jesus"  (1  Tim.  ii.)  has  distinctly,  and  of 
His  own  individuality,  a  Body  which  is  not 
on  earth  but  in  heaven.  The  consecrated 
Bread  and  Wine  are  not  to  be  adored  as 
having  been  transmuted  into  the  "natural," 
but  now  glorified,  Flesh  and  Blood  of  Christ 
(See  Hooker,  K  P.,  bk.  v.  c.  55 ;  Bp.  Harold 
I3rowne,  On  tJie  Articles,  p.  107,  n.  2,  and 
p.  707,  11  ed.). 

II.  It  is  plain,  however,  that  the  phrase 
"  the  Real  Presence  "  may  more  properly 
be  applied  to  express  such  a  presence,  in 
fact,  of  that  which  is  spoken  of  as  accords 
with  its  true  nature  and  properties.  To 
confine  the  phrase  to  what  is  known  as  the 
Corporal  Presence  is  to  imply  that  no  other 
Presence  is  in  fact  conceivable.  And  this  is 
to  bring  in  a  particular  theory  concerning 
the  nature  of  the  heavenly  Food  received  in 
the  Sacrament  of  the  Lord's  Supper  which 
the  Church  of  England  has  refused  to  adopt. 
But  to  those  who  believe  that  "  with  the 
natural  bread  in  the  Sacrament  there  is 
present  the  Spiritual  Bread  which  is  Christ's 
Body,"  there  is  no  difficulty  in  confessing 
this  presence  to  be  real.  Difficulty  can 
exist  only  when  that  which  is  spiritual  is 
conceived  to  be  incapable  of  any  proper 
presence  with  us  at  all.  But  as  the  thought 
of  the  presence  of  God  with  men,  of  the  Lord 
Jesus  Christ  in  the  assemblies  of  the  Church, 
of  the  holy  angels,  is  everywhere  familiar  to 
the  Christian  mind,  so  too  the  mind  can 
conceive  the  real  presence  of  Spiritual  Food, 
if  only  it  be  conceded  that  such  Pood  is  then 
taken  and  received  in  the  Sacrament  of  the 
Lord's  Supper. 

The  Church,  as  represented  by  her  best 
writers,  declines  to  localise  this  Presence  or 
to  define  the  connection  of  it  with  the 
consecrated  Bread  and  Wine.  She  prefers 
to  emphasize  the  fact  that  the  soul  of  the 
devout  communicant  is  "  the  receptacle  of 
Christ's  presence."  Not  indeed  "to  be 
sougJit  for,"  as  Hooker  says,  "in  the 
Sacrament,  but  in  the  worthy  receiver  of 
the  Sacrament,"  it  is  still  no  mere  creation 
of  the  devout  feelings  of  the  soul.  The 
spiritual  and  heavenly  Food  received  is  the 
res  sacramenti,  "  an  external  reality  "  (to 
use  Dr.  Mozley's  phrase),  "coining  to  us 
from  without  ourselves,  and  ha"ving  existence 
independently  of  our  own  thought "  (as 
writes  Bishop  Moberley),  but  communicat- 
ing its  effectual  power  only  to  the  devout 
recipient. 

Thus  the  use  of  the  phrase  we  are 
considering,  in  the  EngUsh  Church,  may 
be  regarded  as  a  protest  against  the  Zuing- 
lian  doctrine  of  a  mere  abstract  influence 
upon  the  minds  of  communicants.  The 
Real  Presence  is  the  presence  of  the 
spiritual  Food  according  to  Its  own  nature 
and   the   properties   of   its   existence.     To 


REALISTS 

assert  a  real  spiritual  Presence  is  to  hold 
thnt  the  Body  and  Blood  of  Christ  "are 
verily  and  indeed  taken  and  received  by 
the  faithful  in  the  Lord's  Supper ;  "  "  that 
in  the  Supper  of  the  Lord  there  is  no  vain 
ceremony,  no  base  sign,  no  untrue  figure  of 
a  thing  absent."  "  It  teaches,"  to  use  the 
words  of  bishop  Browne  (Articles,  p.  678), 
"  that  Christ  is  really  received  by  fiiithful 
communicants  in  the  Lord's  Supper  out 
that  there  is  no  gross  or  carnal,  but  only  a 
spiritual  and  heavenly  presence  there ;  not 
the  less  real,  however,  for  being  spiritual. 
It  teaches,  therefore,  that  the  Bread  and 
Wine  are  received  naturally;  but  the  Body 
and  Blood  of  Christ  are  received  spiritually, 
'  the  result  of  which  doctrine  is  this  :  it  is 
bread,  and  it  is  Christ's  Body.  It  is  bread 
in  substance,  Christ  in  Sacrament ;  and 
Chiist  is  as  really  given  to  all  that  are  truly 
disposed,  as  the  symbols  are  :  each  as  they 
can ;  Christ  as  Christ  can  be  given ;  the 
bread  and  wine  as  they  can ;  and  to  the 
same  real  purposes  to  which  they  were 
designed :  and  Christ  does  as  really  nourish 
and  sanctify  the  soul  as  the  elements  the 
body '  (Jer.  Taylor,  On  tlie  Real  Presence, 
sect.  i.  4)."     [J.  G.  H.] 

REALISTS.  The  Realists,  who  followed 
the  doctrine  of  Aristotle  with  respect  to 
universal  ideas,  were  so  called  in  opposition 
to  the  Nominalists  (see  Nominalists),  who 
embraced  the  hypothesis  of  Zeno  and  the 
Stoics  upon  that  perplexed  and  intricate 
subject.  Aristotle  held,  against  Plato,  that, 
previous  to,  and  independent  of,  matter, 
there  were  no  universal  ideas  or  essences; 
and  that  the  ideas,  or  exemplars,  which  the 
latter  supposed  to  have  existed  in  the 
Divine  mind,  and  to  have  been  the  models 
of  all  created  things,  had  been  eternally 
impressed  upon  matter,  and  were  coeval 
with,  and  inherent  in,  their  objects.  Zeno 
and  his  followers,  departing  both  from  the 
Platonic  and  Aristotelian  systems,  main- 
tained that  these  pretended  universals  had 
neither  form  nor  essence,  and  were  no  more 
than  mere  terms  and  nominal  representations 
of  their  particiilar  objects.  The  doctrine 
of  Aristotle  prevailed  untU  the  eleventh 
century,  when  Koscelinus  embraced  the 
Stoical  system,  and  founded  the  sect  of  the 
Nominalists,  whose  sentiments  were  propa- 
gated with  great  success  by  the  famous 
Abelard.  These  two  sects  differed  con- 
siderably among  themselves,  and  explained, 
or  rather  obscured,  their  respective  tenets 
in  a  variety  of  ways. — Stubbs'  Mosheim, 
vol.  ii.  19,  107. 

RECANTATION  (See  Abjuration). 

RECTOR  (From  regere ;  as   a  priest  is 

■said  to  rule  his  people).     A  term  applied  to 

several    persons    whose     offices    are    verj' 

different,  as,  1.  The  rector  of  a  parish  is  a 


REFOKMATION 


C41 


clergyman  who  has  the  cliarge  and  care 
of  a  parish,  and  possesses  all  the  tithes,  &c. 
When  a  layman  has  the  great  tithes  he  is 
called  the  "lay  rector."  A  rector  in  1250 
was  required  to  maintain  the  chancel  with 
its  windows  and  walls  (See  Parson ;  Vicar). 
2.  The  same  name  is  also  given  to  the  head 
in  some  of  our  colleges,  as  Exeter  and 
Lincoln  colleges,  Oxford,  and  also  to  the 
head-master  of  large  schools.  3.  Rector  is 
also  used  in  several  convents  for  the  superior 
oificerwho  governs  the  house.  The  Jesuits 
gave  this  name  to  the  superiors  of  such  of 
their  houses  as  were  either  seminaries  or 
colleges. 

RECUSANT,  from  recusare,  to  "  refuse." 
A  Eecusant,  in  general,  signifies  any  person, 
whether  Papist  or  other,  who  refuses  to 
go  to  church  and  to  worship  God  after  the 
manner  of  the  Chmxh  of  England :  a  Popish 
Becusant  is  a  Papist  who  so  refuses.  The 
provisions  against  Popish  recusants  were  of 
the  most  rigorous  and  oppressive  character, 
and  were  repealed  by  7  &  8  Vict.  c.  102 ; 
and  9  &  10  Vict.  c.  59.— Stephens'  Con- 
ment.  iii.  55. 

REDEEMER,  THE  (Redimere,  to  buy 
back).  A  title  of  our  Lord  and  Saviour 
Jesus  Christ.  "  The  Redeemer  shall  come 
to  Sion"  (Isa.  lix.  20).  "Christ  hath 
redeemed  us  from  the  curse  of  the  law, 
being  made  a  curse  for  us  "  (Gal.  iii.  13). 
"  Redeemed  with  the  precious  blood  of 
Christ"  (1  St.  Pet.  i.  18,  19).  " Having  ob- 
tained eternal  redemption  for  us  "  (Heb.  ix. 
12).  See  also  Job.  xxxiii.  23,  24 ;  St.  Matt, 
xxvi.  28;  Rom.  iii.  24;  1  Cor.  i.  30;  Eph. 
i.  7  ;  Rev.  v.  9. 

REDEMPTION  denotes  our  rescue  from 
sin  and  death,  _by  the  obedience  and 
sacrifice  of  Christ,  who  on  this  account  is 
called  the  "Redeemer"  (Isa.  lix.  20;  Job 
xix.  25)     (See  Covenant  of  Redemption). 

REFORMATION.  The  great  movement 
in  the  Western  Church  in  the  sixteenth 
century,  the  object  of  which  was  to  remove 
the  errors  and  superstitions  which  had  crept 
into  the  Church  during  the  Middle  Ages, 
and  to  "  reform "  her  on  the  basis  of 
primitive  simplicity.  The  scandalous 
practices  connected  with  the  sale  of  in- 
dulgences set  a  spark  to  the  train  that 
had  gradually  been  prepared,  and  on  the 
continent  the  flame  spread  rapidly  (See 
Luther).  The  danger  was,  and  it  was  not 
avoided,  of  over  zeal  on  the  part  of  the 
Reformers.  In  England,  it  must  be  re- 
membered, the  Reformation  of  our  Church 
did  not  consist  of  one  revolutionary  act; 
but  that  it  was  a  series  of  events  extending 
over  at  least  a  century  and  a  half,  which 
was  capable  of  being  at  one  time  retarded 
at  another  resumed,  according  to  circum- 
stances, and  which  was  in  some  measure 

2  T 


C42 


EEFOEMATION 


dependent  upon  the  ascendency  or  depression 
of  rival  factions  (Hook's  Archbislwps,  vi. 
41;  ix.  32).  The  Church  of  England 
always  maintained  her  independence,  and 
was  never  under  the  supremacy  of  the 
Church  of  Rome.  In  fact,  her  history  from 
the  time  of  Theodore  to  the  Reformation 
shows  one  continual  endeavour  on  the  part 
of  the  Church  of  Rome  to  get  her  under  the 
supremacy  of  the  pope,  and  a  determination 
on  her  part  to  maintain  her  freedom.  Now 
the  separation  was  to  be  made  more  com- 
plete. It  began  in  the  reign  of  King  Henry 
VIIL,  and  was  established  in  that  of  Queen 
Elizabeth,  and  confirmed  in  1661. 

King  Henry  VIII.  was  at  first  a  great 
favourer  of  the  see  of  Rome.  No  one  dis- 
covered more  zeal  for  it  than  he  did  in  the 
beginning  of  his  reign.v  He  even  wrote  a 
book  against  Luther,  eh,titled,  "Of  the 
Seven  Sacraments ;  "  and  this  gained  him 
the  new  title  of  "  Defender  of  the  Faith," 
which  Pope  Leo  X.  bestowed  upon  him  by 
a  buU,  and  which  his  successors  have  pre- 
sei'ved  ever  since  their  separation  from  the 
Chmcli  of  Rome.  But  this  zeal  for  the 
see  of  Rome  was  greatly  cooled  when  that 
court  refused  to  grant  him  the  satisfaction 
he  expected  with  regard  to  his  intended 
divorce  from  Queen  Catherine.  This  was 
clearly  his  first  motive  for  separating  from 
that  Church. 

Cranmer,  whom  the  king  had  raised  to 
the  see  of  Canterbury,  in  compliance  with 
Henry's  desire,  dissolved  his  marriage  by 
a  sentence  pronounced  May  23, 1533,  with- 
out waiting  for  the  sentence  of  the  court 
of  Rome.  This  step  made  way  for  another. 
For  the  parliament  passed  an  Act,  that 
for  the  future  no  person  should  appeal  to 
the  court  of  Rome,  in  any  case  whatever ; 
but  that  they  should  all  be  judged  within 
the  realm  by  the  prelates :  that  neither 
first  fruits,  annates,  nor  St.  Peter's  pence 
should  any  more  be  paid ;  nor  palls  or 
buUs  for  bishoprics  be  any  longer  fetched 
from  Rome ;  and  that  whoever  infringed 
this  statute  should  be  severely  punished. 
Clement  VII.  threatened  Henry  with  ex- 
communication, in  case  he  refused  to 
acknowledge  his  fault,  by  restoring  things 
to  their  former  state,  and  taking  back 
his  queen.  However,  Francis  I.,  king  of 
France,  interposed,  and,  in  the  interview 
which  he  had  with  the  pope  at  Marseilles, 
he  prevailed  with  him  to  suspend  the 
excommunication  tiU  such  time  as  he 
had  employed  his  endeavours  to  make 
Henry  return  to  the  obedience  of  the  holy 
see.  To  this  purpose  he  sent  John  de 
Bellay,  bishop  of  Paris,  to  King  Henry,  who 
gave  him  some  hopes  of  his  submission, 
provided  the  pope  would  delay  the  excom- 
munication.    Clement,  though  he  conld  not 


REFORMATION 

refuse  so  just  a  request,  yet  limited  the 
delay  to  so  short  a  time  that,  before  Henry 
could  come  to  any  determinate  resolution, 
the  time  was  lapsed,  and,  no  news  coming 
from  England,  excommunication  was  pro- 
nounced at  Rome,  and  set  up  in  all  the 
usual  places. 

The  effects  of  this  excommunication  wero 
very  fatal  to  the  see  of  Rome.  The  pope, 
who  began  to  repent  of  his  over-hasty  pro- 
ceedings, found  it  imjDossible  to  appease 
King  Henry.  For  that  monarch  now  threw 
off  all  restraint,  and  openly  separated  from 
the  see  of  Rome.  The  parliament  declared 
him  supreme  head  of  the  Church  of  England, 
and  granted  him  the  annates  and  first  fruits, 
the  tenths  of  the  revenues  of  all  benefices, 
and  the  power  of  nominating  to  all  bishoprics. 
The  parliament  also  passed  another  Act,  ta 
deprive  all  persons  charged  with  treason 
of  the  privilege  of  sanctuary.  And  thus 
ended  the  pope's  power  in  England,  a.d, 
1543. 

The  king  met  with  little  or  no  opposition, 
in  the  prosecution  of  his  designs,  from  the- 
laity,  who  had  the  utmost  aversion  and 
contempt  for  the  clergy,  and  were  extremely 
scandalized  at  the  vicious  and  debauched 
lives  of  the  monks.  But  these  latter 
preached  with  great  vehemence  against 
these  innovations,  and  the  priests  prevailed 
with  the  peasants  in  the  North  of  England 
to  rise.  However,  the  mutineers  accepted 
of  a  general  pardon,  laid  down  their  arms, 
and  took  them  up  again ;  but  being  de- 
feated, and  most  of  their  leaders  executed, 
they  were  obliged  to  submit.  John  Fisher,, 
bishop  of  Rochester,  who  had  been  the 
king's  tutor,  and  the  learned  Sir  Thomas- 
More,  lord  chancellor,  were  beheaded  for 
refusing  to  acknowledge  the  king's  supre- 
macy. King  Henry  himself,  though  he 
abrogated  the  authority  of  the  see  of  Rome 
in  England,  constantly  adhered  to  the 
doctrines  and  principles  of  that  Church, 
and  caused  some  Protestants  to  be  burned. 
The  ruin  of  the  papal  authority  brought 
on  a  reformation  in  the  doctrine,  worship, 
and  discipline  of  the  Church  of  England. 
All  the  monasteries  were  dissolved,  and  the 
monks  set  adrift,  and  several  of  the  abbots 
and  priors  hung.  The  Bible  was  printed 
in  English,  and  set  up  by  public  authority 
in  all  the  churches ;  and  the  ceremonies  of 
the  Church  were  greatly  altered.  But  King 
Henry,  dying  in  1547,  left  the  Reformation 
imperfect,  and,  as  it  were,  in  its  infancy. 

In  the  succeeding  i"eign,  Seymour,  Duke 
of  Somerset,  regent  and  protector  during  the 
minority  of  Edward  VI.,  endeavoured  to 
forward  the  Reformation,  in  which  the 
parliament  supported  him  with  all  their 
power.  For  he  abolished  private  masses, 
restored  the  cup  to  the  laity,  took  away  the 


REFORMATION 

images  out  of  the  cliurches,  and  caused  the 
Book  of  Common  Prayer  to  be  revised  and 
corrected.  But  the  fraudulent  proceedings 
of  the  nobility,  together  with  a  great  laxity 
of  morals  spreadmg  among  the  people,  gave 
the  enemies  of  the  Reformation  a  great 
handle  against  them.  Their  insatiable 
scrambling  after  the  goods  and  wealth  that 
had  been  dedicated  with  good  design, 
without  applying  any  part  of  it  to  tbe 
promotion  of  the  Gosijel,  the  instruction  of 
the  youth,  and  the  relief  of  the  poor,  made 
all  people  conclude  it  was  for  robbery,  and 
not  for  reformation,  that  their  zeal  made 
them  so  active  (^Burnet,  iii.  216).  Somer- 
set himself  had  received  from  Henry  VIII. 
tliree  religious  houses,  and  one  of  his  first 
acts  as  Protector  was  to  endow  himself  with 
five  or  six  more  (Hook's  Archbishops,  vii, 
221).  In  this  reign  the  Keformation  was 
solemnly  confirmed  by  the  legislature,  and 
had  the  sanction  of  an  Act  of  both  houses 
of  parliament.  So  many  alterations  occa- 
sioned great  disorders  in  the  kingdom.  The 
common  people,  having  now  not  so  easy  an 
opportunity  of  getting  a  livelihood,  because 
of  the  great  number  of  monks,  who,  being 
driven  out  of  the  suppressed  monasteries, 
were  obliged  to  work ;  this  fomented  the 
discontent,  insomuch  that  several  counties 
of  England  took  up  arms.  But  the  rebels, 
after  having  been  defeated  in  several  en- 
gagements, accepted  of  the  general  pardon 
that  was  offered  them. 

The  Reformation  met  with  a  great  inter- 
ruption during  the  reign  of  Queen  Mary,  who, 
being  a  bigoted  Roman  Catholic,  began  her 
reign  with  setting  at  liberty  the  papists,  re- 
storing the  popish  prelates  to  their  sees,  and 
allowing  a  general  liberty  of  conscience  till 
the  sitting  of  the  parliament,  ia  which  an 
Act  was  passed,  prohibiting  the  exercise  of 
any  other  religion  but  the  Roman  Catholic. 
Having  strengthened  herself  by  a  marriage 
with  Philip  II.,  king  of  Spain,  she  called  a 
new  parliament,  in  which  Phihp  and  herself 
presided.  Cardinal  Pole  made  a  fine  speech 
in  it,  after  which  both  houses  suppressed 
the  reformed  religion,  and  restored  the 
Church  to  the  same  state  it  was  in  before 
the  divorce  of  King  Henry  VIII.  At  the 
same  time  the  above-mentioned  cardinal 
reconciled  the  nation  to  the  Church  of 
Rome,  after  having  absolved  it  from  all 
ecclesiastical  censures.  Great  numbers, 
however,  still  adhered  to  the  profession  of 
the  reformed  religion,  whom  Queen  Mary 
punished  with  great  severity,  and  burnt 
some  hundreds  of  them,  among  whom  were 
Cranmer,  archbishop  of  Canterbury,  and  four 
other  bishops. 

"  The  generality  of  men,"  says  Professor 
Brewer,  "  are  too  much  misled  by  Foxe  in 
forming    anythiog    like    a    fair    and    just 


REGALE 


^43 


estimate  of  the  reigns  of  King  Edward 
and  his  successor.  No  king  ever  lived  in 
this  nation,  except  perhaps  Henry  VIII., 
whose  reign  was  more  disastrous  to  the 
cause  of  true  religion,  and  consequently  to 
the  Church,  than  was  the  reign  of  Edward 
VI.  As  Bishop  Burnet  states,  men  were 
fast  falling  away  from  the  truth  altogether, 
or  turning  back  to  their  ancient  professions 
and  opinions.  It  was  the  fires  that  were 
lighted  in  Smithfield  which  brought  men 
again,  if  not  to  soberer  feelings,  yet  at  least 
to  greater  caution.  Persecution,  while  it 
purged  the  Reformation  to  a  great  extent  of 
those  who  had  supported  it  merely  because 
it  allowed  a  greater  laxity  than  Romanism, 
threw  a  halo  round  those  who  suffered,  a 
feeling  of  pity  and  respect  for  them,  and  of 
veneration  for  those  opinions  for  which  they 
suffered,  which  a  milder  policy  had  never 
produced.  Without  any  such  intention, 
Queen  Mary  did  far  more  for  the  Refor- 
mation than  either  of  her  immediate  pre- 
decessors" (Brewer,  Notes  on  Fuller, 
bk.  viii.  p.  150).  Hence  the  way  was 
prepared,  at  the  accession  of  Elizabeth,  for 
proceeding  with  refonns  which,  at  the  same 
time,  were  kept  in  check  by  the  judicious 
care  of  the  heads  of  the  Church.     [H.] 

REFRESHMENT  SUNDAY  (See  Mid- 
Lent  Sunday). 

REFUGE  (See  Sanctuarij). 

REFUGE,  Cities  of.  In  the  Levitical 
law  six  cities  were  appointed  by  the  com- 
mand of  God  as  cities  of  refuge  for  those 
who  might  by  accident,  and  without  malice, 
unhappily  slay  another.  There  they  were 
to  dwell  till  the  death  of  the  high  priest ; 
and  if  caught  before  they  came  thither,  or 
afterwards  awaj'  from  the  city,  they  might 
be  slain  by  the  avenger  of  blood  (Exod. 
XX.  13  ;  Numb.  xxxv.  11,  &c.). 

REGALE.  The  claim  on  the  part  of  the 
sovereign  of  a  country  to  enjoy  the  incomes 
of  vacant  bishoprics,  and  to  present  to  all 
ecclesiastical  preferments  except  the  ordi- 
nary parochial  cures. 

Some  of  the  French  writers  assert  that 
all  the  kings  of  France  of  the  first  race,  and 
some  of  the  second,  have  had  the  entire 
disposal  of  bishoprics  throughout  their  do- 
minions. This  right,  they  say,  was  given 
to  the  kings  of  Prance  by  way  of  recom- 
pense for  their  protectmg  the  orthodox  faith ; 
and  that  this  privilege  was  granted  by  the 
first  Council  of  Orleans  to  Clovis,  the  first 
Christian  king  of  the  Franks,  after  he  had 
defeated  Alario,  an  Arian  prince.  Other 
authors  afSrm  that  this  privilege  is  not 
founded  upon  grant,  but  comes  from  the  right 
of  patronage,  which  the  king  has  over  all  the 
churches  in  his  kingdom,  from  his  feudal 
right  over  the  temporalities  of  benefices,  and 
from  his  right  of  protection  of  ecclesiastics 

2  T  2 


644 


EEGENEKATE 


and  the  goods  of  the  Church.  But  however 
the  kings  of  France  have  desisted  from  the 
right  of  patronage  over  all  the  benefices  of 
the  kingdom,  they  still  retain  the  right  of 
appropriating  to  themselves  the  revenues  of 
vacant  bishoprics ;  and  this  is  what  they 
call  the  Regale. 

This  right  takes  place  all  over  the  king- 
dom, though  some  archbishoprics  and  bishop- 
rics have  pretended  to  an  exemption  from 
it.  The  abbeys  were  formerly  subject  there- 
to, but  have  been  discharged. 

REGENERATE,  REGENERATION 
(See  Conversion,  Eenovation).  Every  bap- 
tized child  is  called  regenerate.  There  have 
been  some  very  unreasonable  exceptions 
taken  against  this  expression ;  as  if  all 
persons  who  are  baptized  were  truly  con- 
verted, whereas  several  of  them  prove  aftei- 
wards  very  wicked.  But  this  objection  is 
grounded  upon  a  modern  notion  of  the  word 
"regeneration,"  which  neither  the  ancient 
Fathers  of  the  Church  nor  the  compilers  of 
our  liturgy  knew  anything  of. 

Our  Lord,  according  to  the  gospel  of  St. 
Matthew,  used  this  word,  when  He  told  His 
disciples  "  that  ye  which  have  followed  Me, 
in  the  regeneration  (eV  rfi  naXiyyeveo-lq) 
when  the  Bon  of  Man  shall  sit  in  the  throne 
of  His  glory,  ye  shall  also  sit  upon  twelve 
thrones,  judging  the  twelve  tribes  of  Israel" 
(St.  Matt.  xix.  28).  St.  Paul  uses  the  word 
when  he  speaks  of  "  the  washing  of  re- 
generation" (Sta  XovrpoD  7raKtyy€V€(Tias), 
and  "renewing  of  the  Holy  Ghost"  (Tit. 
iii.  5).  St.  Peter  uses  an  equivalent 
term  twice ;  "  according  to  His  abundant 
mercy  [God]  hath  begotten  us  again" 
(dvayyepirtia-ai),  and  "  being  begotten  again 
ldvayeycvvr]fi.€Vos),  not  of  corruptible  seed, 
but  of  incorruptible,  by  the  Word  of  God, 
which  liveth  and  abideth  for  ever  "  (1  St. 
Pet.  i.  3,  23).  The  idea  of  a  spiritual  be- 
getting, without  mention  of  it  as  a  second 
begetting,  is  found  in  St.  John  i.  13 :  iii.  9  : 
iv.  7,  &c.:  and  1  Cor.  iv.  15;  Phil.  10. 
Wheresoever  the  term  is  used  it  seems  to 
be  an  implication  of  the  adoption  of  the 
person  into  the  Church  of  Christ,  and  is 
distinctly  associated  with  the  use  of  water, 
and  the  work  of  the  Holy  Ghost.  The 
words  of  our  Lord  convey  this  idea, "  Except 
■  one  be  begotten  from  above  (eai/  fifj  ns 
yfvvrjBTj  ava>6(v) — of  the  water  and  of  the 
Spirit  (Jav  fii)  TLS  yivvrjBrj  e^  vSaroi  Koi 
OT/cu/iOTos) — he  cannot  enter  into  the  king- 
dom of  God"  (St.  John.  iii.  3,  5).  In 
the  language  of  the  Fathers  regeneration 
signifies  the  participation  of  the  sacrament 
of  baptism.  The  Greek  writers  have  a 
variety  of  words  to  express  regeneration ; 
not  only  by  avayevvriats,  which  is  an  exact 
translation  of  it,  but  dvoKaivLcrfios,  "  renova- 
tion ;  "  avaviaxn!,  "  renewing ;  "  avdcrrao-is, 


REGENERATE 

" resurrection ;"/iETan-oi7;trtr,  the  "refitting ;" 
jraXtyyfi/eo-i'a,  the  being  "born  again;" 
TraXtn-oKia,  the  "  begetting  again ; "  all  which 
expres-sions  are  used  of  baptism,  and  seldom 
or  never  of  the  rise  after  a  lapse.  The 
language  of  the  Latin  Fathers  is  the  same. 
The  Latin  translator  of  Irenajus  expresses 
the  Greek  avayiwqtns  by  "  regeneration ;  " 
"baptism  which  is  a  regeneration  unto 
God ;  "  and  likewise  calls  the  dvay(yfvvr)ij.4voi 
the  baptized,  "  regenerati "  the  "  regenerate." 
St.  Ambrose,  speaking  of  baptism,  says : 
"  By  baptism  we  are  renewed,  by  which  also 
we  are  born  again."  St.  Augustine,  besides 
many  other  passages,  within  the  compass  of 
a  few  lines,  has  several  expressions  all  to 
this  purpose.  He  calls  baptism  "  the 
spiritual  regeneration ; "  he  says  the  baptized 
person  "  is  born  again,  because  he  is  re- 
generated;" and  lastly  he  calls  baptism 
"  the  sacrament  of  regeneration."  And  in 
another  place  he  puts  forward  a  question 
whether  the  baptism  of  the  schismatioal 
Donatists  does  confer  regeneration  or  not, 
but  never  doubted  whether  that  of  the 
Catholics  did  so.  The  returning  to  God 
after  a  state  of  sin  was  expressed  differently. 
The  Greek  writers  use  the  word  /icTa/xeXfm, 
fieravoia,  &0.,  &c.,  the  Latins,  pcenitentia, 
conversio.  The  language  of  the  schools  is 
exactly  that  of  the  Latin  Fathers  on  this 
point ;  they  make  the  effect  of  baptism  to 
be  a  "regeneration,"  or  a  "  generation  to  a 
spiritual  life ; "  but  the  turning  to  God  after 
a  course  of  sin  they  call  either  "  penitence," 
or  "  conversion  to  God."  The  most  eminent 
divines  of  the  Reformation  use  these  words 
in  the  ancient  sense.  Peter  Martyr  uses 
"  regeneration  "  for  baptism,  and  calls  the 
turning  to  God  after  a  state  of  sin  the 
"  conversion  and  change  of  a  man."  Calvin, 
where  he  designs  to  speak  with  exactness, 
uses  "regeneration"  for  the  baptismal  re- 
novation, as  in  his  catechism ;  though  some- 
times he  uses  it  to  signify  conversion,  but 
this  is  but  seldom ;  he  generally,  with  the 
ancient  Latin  writers,  expressed  this  by 
"  conversion."  When  the  Quinquarticular 
controversy  arose,  and  long  treatises  were 
written  about  the  methods  of  converting 
grace,  the  divines  who  managed  them  being 
willing  sometimes  to  vary  their  expressions 
to  make  these  discourses  (dry  enough  in 
themselves)  thereby  something  more  plea- 
sant, began  to  use  "  regeneration "  as  a 
synonymous  word  with  "  conversion.''  But 
in  the  Synod  of  Dort  itself,  though  in  some 
of  the  particular  declarations  of  the  divines 
of  the  several  countries  "  regeneration  "  and 
"  conversion  "  are  used  reciprocally,  yet  in  the 
synodical  resolutions  the  word  "  conversion  " 
if  always  used.  In  the  sermons  and  hooks 
written  about  the  beginning  of  the  civil  war, 
" regeneration "  for  " repentance "  or  "con- 


EEGENEKATE 

version "  became  a  very  fashionable  word, 
and  it  was  often  oddly  expressed  as  re- 
generation-work. Bishop  Bethell  states  that 
although  in  a  few  rare  cases  the  term  "  re- 
generation "  was  used  in  olden  times  for  the 
idea  of  a  transition  from  a  state  of  sin  to  a 
state  of  hoUness,  yet  the  general  and  only 
usual  sense  of  the  word  is  that  of  such  a 
transition  in  and  hy  the  act  of  baptism. 
"  In  those  few  passages  of  the  ancient 
Christian  writers  where  it  bears  another 
signification,  it  is  used  apparently  in  a 
figurative  manner,  to  express  such  a  change 
as  seemed  to  bear  some  analogy  in  magnitude 
and  importance  to  the  change  effected  in 
baptism  "  (Bethell,  On  Regeneration,  p.  7. 
And  see  Mozley,  On  Regeneration). 

The  importance  of  holding  this  doctrine, 
besides  its  being  scripturally  true,  must  be 
at  once  apparent  to  those  who  reflect  that 
the  whole  moral  education  of  a  Christian 
people  is  altered,  if  instead  of  teaching 
them,  as  we  ought  to  do,  that  God  1ms 
given  them  a  gift  which  they  may  use  to 
their  own  salvation,  but  for  losing  which 
they  will  be  awfully  punished, — if  instead 
of  this  we  tell  them  to  wait  and  to  e.Kpect 
the  gift  of  grace,  before  receiving  which 
they  cannot  please  God.  The  orthodox 
would  preach  to  all  baptized  persons,  tell- 
ing them  that  they  may  and  can  serve 
God  if  they  will :  the  heterodox  would 
address  baptized  persons  as  heathens,  and 
warn  them  that,  until  they  have  an  effec- 
tual calling,  they  can  do  nothing.  It  is 
easy  to  trace  much  of  the  evil  which  dis- 
graces the  religion  of  the  present  day  to 
the  prevalence  of  the  latter  notion. 

At  the  Savoy  Commission,  1661,  the  fol- 
lowing are  among  the  answers  of  the  bishops 
to  the  objections  of  ministers. 

"Eeceive  remission  of  sins  by  spiritual 
regeneration."  Most  proper,  for  baptism 
is  our  spiritual  regeneration  (St.  John  iii.  5), 
"  Unless  a  man  be  born  again  of  water  and 
the  Spirit,"  &c.  And  by  this  is  received 
remission  of  sins  (Acts  ii.  38),  "  Kepent,  and 
be  baptized  every  one  of  you  for  the  re- 
mission of  sins."  So  the  Creed :  "  one  bap- 
tism for  the  remission  of  sins." 

Seeing  that  God's  sacraments  have  their 
effects,  where  the  receiver  doth  not  "  ponere 
obicem,"  put  any  bar  against  them  (which 
children  cannot  do_);  we  may  say  in  faith 
of  every  child  that  is  baptized,  that  it  is 
regenerated  by  God's  Holy  Spirit ;  and 
the  denial  of  it  tends  to  Anabaptism,  and 
the  contempt  of  this  holy  sacrament,  as 
nothing  worthy,  nor  material  whether  it 
be  administered  to  children  or  no. 

[The  form  of  Confirmation]  supposes, 
and  that  truly,  that  all  children  were  at 
their  baptism  regenerate  by  water  and  the 
Holy    Ghost,   and   had   given   unto   them 


REGISTER 


C45 


forgiveness  of  all  their  sins ;  and  it  is 
charitably  presumed,  that  notwithstanding 
the  frailties  and  slips  of  their  childhood, 
they  have  not  totally  lost  what  was  in 
baptism  conferred  upon  them. — Cardwell's 
Hist,  of  Conferences,  pp.  356,  358. 

REGISTER.  The  keeping  of  a  church 
book  for  registering  the  age  of  those  that 
should  be  born  and  christened  in  the  par- 
ish began  in  the  thirtieth  year  of  Henry 

viri. 

By  Canon  70.  "In  every  parish  church 
and  chapel  within  this  realm  shall  be  pro- 
vided one  parchment  book  at  the  charge 
of  the  parish,  wherein  shall  be  written  the 
day  and  year  of  every  christening,  wed- 
ding, and  burial,  which  have  been  in  the 
parish  since  the  time  that  the  law  was 
first  made  in  that  behalf,  so  far  as  the 
ancient  books  thereof  can  be  procured, 
but  especially  since  the  beginning  of  the 
reign  of  the  late  queen.  And  for  the  safe 
keeping  of  the  said  book,  the  church- 
wardens, at  the  charge  of  the  parish,  shall 
provide  one  sure  coffer  and  three  locks 
and  keys  ;  whereof  one  to  remain  with  the 
minister,  and  the  other  two  with  the 
churchwardens  severally ;  so  that  neither 
the  minister  without  the  two  church- 
wardens, nor  the  churchwardens  without 
the  minister,  shall  at  any  time  take  that 
book  out  of  the  said  coffer.  And  hence- 
forth upon  every  sabbath  day  immediately 
after  morning  or  evening  prayer,  the 
minister  and  the  churchwardens  shall  take 
the  said  parchment  book  out  of  the  said 
coffer,  and  the  minister  in  the  presence  of 
the  churchwardens  shall  write  and  record 
in  the  said  book  the  names  of  all  persons 
christened,  together  with  the  names  and 
surnames  of  their  parents,  and  also  the 
names  of  all  persons  married  and  buried 
in  that  parish  in  the  week  before,  and  the 
day  and  year  of  every  such  christening, 
marriage,  and  burial ;  and  that  done,  they 
shall  lay  up  the  book  in  the  coffer  as 
before.  And  the  minister  and  church- 
wardens, unto  every  page  of  that  book, 
when  it  shall  be  filled  with  such  inscrip- 
tions, shall  subscribe  their  names.  And 
the  churchwaidens  shall  once  every  year, 
within  one  month  after  the  five  and 
twentieth  day  of  March,  transmit  unto  the 
bishop  of  the  diocese,  or  his  chancellor,  a 
true  copy  of  the  names  of  all  persons 
christened,  married,  or  buried  in  their 
parish  in  the  year  before  (ended  the  said 
five  and  twentieth  day  of  March),  and  the 
certain  days  and  months  in  which  every 
christening,  marriage,  and  burial  was  had, 
to  be  subscribed  to  with  the  hands  of  the 
said  minister  and  churchwardens,  to  the 
end  the  same  may  faithfully  be  preserved 
in  the  registry  of  the  said  bishop ;  which 


616 


EEGISTEE 


certificate  shall  be  received  without  fee. 
And  if  the  minister  and  churchwai-dens 
shall  be  negligent  in  perfonnance  of  any- 
thing herein  contained,  it  shall  be  lawful 
for  the  bishop,  or  his  chancellor,  to  con- 
vent them  and  proceed  against  every  of 
them,  as  contemners  of  this  our  constitu- 
tion." 

The  Act  52  Geo.  III.  c.  146  (a.d.  1812) 
directs  that  "  registers  of  public  and  pri- 
vate baptisms,  marriages,  and  burials, 
solemnised  according  to  the  rites  of  the 
United  Church  of  England  and  Ireland, 
.  .  .  shall  be  made  and  kept  by  the  rector, 
vicar,  curate,  or  officiating  minister  of  everj"^ 
parish  (or  of  any  chapelry)  where  the 
ceremonies  of  baptism,  marriage,  and  burial, 
have  been  usually,  and  may  according  to 
law  be,  performed  for  the  time  being,  in 
books  of  parchment,  or  of  good  and  durable 
paper,  to  be  provided  by  his  Majesty's 
printer  as  occasion  may  require,  at  the 
expense  of  the  respective  parishes  or 
chapelries ;  whereon  shall  be  printed,  upon 
each  side  of  every  leaf,  the  heads  of  in- 
formation herein  required  to  be  entered 
in  the  registers"  (agreeably  to  schedules 
annexed  to  the  Act).  Such  registers  should 
be  kept  in  separate  books,  and  every 
minister  shall  enter  the  baptism,  or  burial, 
as  soon  as  possible,  and  shall  sign  the 
same  ;  "  and  in  no  case,  unless  prevented 
by  sickness,  or  other  unavoidable  impedi- 
ment, later  than  within  seven  days  after 
the  ceremony  of  any  such  baptism,  or 
burial,  shall  have  taken  place  "  (Sect.  3). 

"Whenever  the  ceremony  of  baptism, 
or  burial,  shall  be  performed  in  any  other 
place  than  the  parish  church,  or  church- 
yard of  any  parish  (or  the  chapel,  or 
chapel-yard  of  any  chapelry,  providing  its 
own  distinct  registers),  and  such  ceremony 
shall  be  performed  by  any  minister  not 
being  the  rector,  vicar,  minister,  or  curate, 
of  any  such  parish  or  chapelry,  the  minis- 
ter who  shall  perform  such  ceremony  of 
baptism  or  burial  shall,  on  the  same,  or 
on  the  next  day,  transmit  to  the  rector, 
clear,  or  other  minister  of  such  parish  or 
chapelry,  or  his  curate,  a  certificate  of  such 
baptism  or  burial  in  the  form  contained  in 
the  schedule  (D.)  to  this  Act  annexed,  and 
the  rector,  vicar,  minister,  or  curate  of  such 
parish  or  chapelry,  shall  thereupon  enter 
such  baptism  or  burial  according  to  such 
certificate  in  the  book  kept  persuant  to 
this  Act  for  such  purpose ;  and  shall  add  to 
such  entry  the  following  words,  '  According 

to  the  certificate   of  the  Reverend    

transmitted  to  me  on    the  day  of 

"  /  do  hereby  certify,  that  I  did  on  the 

day  of baptize,  according  to  the 

rites  of  the   Church  of  England,  ,  son 


REGISTER 

[or  "dazighter''\   of  and  ■ ,   his 

wife,  hy  the  name  of . 

To  the  Sector  for,  as  the  case  may  be,] 

of ." 

"'I  do  hereby  certify,  that  on  the 

day  of A.  B.  of ,  aged ,  was 

buried  in  [stating  the  place  of  burial],  and 
that  the  ceremony  of  burial  was  performed 
according   to   the   rites  of  the    Church    of 

England  by  me, . 

To  the  Rector  [or,  as  the  case  may  be,] 

of '"     (Sect.  4). 

Sect.  5  directs,  that  the  new  registers, 
and  also  those  previously  existing,  shall  be 
kept  by  the  minister  of  the  parish,  "  in  a 
dry,  well-painted,  hon  chest,  to  be  provided 
and  repaired  as  occasion  may  require,  at  the 
cost  of  the  parish;  which  chest  shall  be 
constantly  kept  locked  in  some  dry,  safe, 
and  secure  place  within  the  usual  place  of 
residence  of  such  minister,  or  in  the  parish 
church  or  chaiiel." 

Sect.  6  directs,  that  within  two  months 
after  the  expiration  of  every  year,  four 
copies  of  the  registers  for  the  preceding 
year  shall  be  made  on  parchment  by  the 
clergyman,  "  or  by  the  churchwardens, 
chapelwardens,  clerk,  or  other  person  duly 
appointed  for  the  purpose,  under,  and  by 
the  direction  of,  such  rector,  vicar,  curate, 
or  other  resident  or  officiating  minister." 
The  copies  are  to  be  verified  and  signed  by 
the  clergyman  in  a  prescribed  form,  and 
his  signature  is  to  be  attested  by  the 
churchwardens  or  chapelwardens,  or  one 
of  them.  These  copies  are  to  be  sent  by 
post  to  the  diocesan  registrare  (Sect.  7). 
In  case  of  the  minister's  neglecting  to 
verify  the  copies,  the  churchwardens  shall 
certify  his  default  to  the  registrar,  by 
whom  it  shall  be  reported  to  the  bishop 
(Sect.  9).  Any  person  convicted  of  falsi- 
fying a  register,  or  allowing  it  to  be  falsi- 
fied, shall  be  subject  to  transportation  for 
fourteen  years  (Sect.  14). 

Sect.  16  provides,  that  the  Act  shall  not 
affect  the  fees  payable  to  any  minister  for 
giving  extracts  of  registers,  &c. 

The  Act  of  52  Geo.  III.  is  still  in  force 
as  regards  the  registration  of  baptisms  and 
burials  by  clergymen.  But  as  to  marriages, 
an  alteration  has  been  made  by  the  Acts 
6  &  7  Will.  IV.  c.  80,  and  7  Will.  IV.  and 
1  Vic.  c.  22.  By  the  former  of  these  Acts 
the  general  civil  registry  was  instituted. 
Sect.  30  orders,  that  the  Registrar-general 
shall,  at  the  expense  of  the  parish  or 
chapelry,  furnish  the  rector,  vicar,  or  curate, 
of  every  church  or  chapel  in  which  marriages 
may  lawfully  be  solemnized,  duplicate 
register  books  and  forms  for  certified  copies 
thereof.  Sect.  31,  that  every  clergyman, 
immediately  after  every  office  of  matrimony 
solemnized  by  him,  shall  register  in  dupli- 


EEGIUM  DONUM  MONEY 

cate  the  several  particulars  relating  to  tliat 
marriage  according  to  a  new  form,  amiexed 
in  a  schedule  to  the  Act.  Sect.  33  (ex- 
plained by  7  Will.  IV.  and  1  Vict.  c.  22), 
that  the  clergyman  of  every  church  or 
chajwl  shall,  in  the  months  of  April,  July, 
October,  and  January  respectively,  make 
and  deliver  to  the  registrar  of  his  district  a 
true  copy,  certified  by  him  under  his  hand, 
of  all  the  entries  of  marriages  in  the  register 
book  kept  by  him  for  the  three  months 
preceding,  to  the  last  days  of  Marcli,  June, 
September,  and  December  respectively ;  and 
if  there  shall  have  been  no  mamage  since 
the  last  certificate,  shall  certify  the  fact 
under  his  hand ;  and  that  one  copy  of  each 
■duplicate  register  book  shall,  when  filled, 
be  delivered  to  the  superintendent-registrar 
of  the  district.  Sect.  27  of  the  Act  of  1 
Vict,  provides,  that  for  every  entry  in  the 
quarterly  certified  copies  the  clergyman 
shall  receive  sixpence  from  the  registrar, 
■which  sum  is  to  be  repaid  to  the  registrar 
by  the  guardians  or  overseers  of  his  dis- 
trict. 

By  the  Act  of  6  &  7  Will.  IV.  c.  86,  sects. 
42,  43,  any  person  who  shall  refuse,  or 
■without  reasonable  cause  omit,  to  register 
any  marriage  solemnized  by  him,  of  which 
lie  ought  to  register,  and  every  jjerson 
having  the  custody  of  any  register  book, 
■who  shall  carelessly  lose  or  injure  the  same, 
or  carelessly  allow  the  same  to  be  injured 
while  in  his  keeping,  shall  forfeit  a  sum  not 
exceeding  £50  for  every  such  ofl'ence  ;  and 
any  person  who  shall  wilfully  destroy, 
injure,  or  in  any  ■way  falsifiy  any  regis- 
ter book,  or  shall  wilfully  give  any  false 
certificate  or  extract,  shall  be  guilty  of 
felony. 

EEGIUM  DONUM  MONEY.  Money 
allowed  by  government  to  the  Dissenters. 
The  origin  of  it  was  in  the  year  1723.  As 
the  Dissenters  approved  themselves  strong 
friends  to  the  House  of  Brunswick,  they 
enjoyed  favour ;  and,  being  excluded  from 
all  lucrative  preferment  in  the  Church,  the 
prime  minister  wished  to  reward  them  for 
their  loyalty,  and,  by  a  retaining  fee,  to 
preserve  them  steadfast.  A  considerable 
sum,  therefore,  was  annually  lodged  with 
the  heads  of  the  Presbyterians,  Independ- 
ents, and  Baptists,  to  be  distributed  among 
the  necessitous  ministers  of  their  congre- 
gations.   But  that  has  ceased. 

REGULAR.  In  the  continental  churches 
those  persons  are  called  regulars  who  pro- 
fess to  follow  a  certain  rule  (regula)  of  life, 
and  observe  the  three  vows  of  poverty, 
chastity,  and  obedience ;  in  contradistinc- 
tion to  the  seculars,  who  live  compara- 
tively in  the  world.  The  canons  of  the 
non-monastic  cathedrals  were  called  se- 
culars. 


RELICS 


647 


RELICS.  In  the  Roman  Church,  the 
remains  of  the  bodies  or  clothes  of  saints 
or  martyrs,  and  the  instruments  by  which 
they  were  put  to  death,  are  devoutly  pre- 
served, in  honour  of  their  memoi-y  ;  kissed, 
revered,  and  carried  in  procession.  The 
respect  which  was  justly  due  to  the  mar- 
tyrs and  teachers  of  the  Christian  faith,  in 
a  few  ages,  increased  almost  to  adoration : 
and  at  length  adoration  was  really  paid 
both  to  departed  saints,  and  to  relics  of 
holy  men  or  holy  things.  The  abuses  of 
the  Church  of  Rome  with  respect  to  relics 
are  very  great,  and  are  justly  censured  in 
our  22nd  Article. 

In  the  early  ages  of  the  gospel,  when  its 
professors  were  exposed  to  every  species 
of  danger  and  persecution,  it  was  natural 
for  Christians  to  show  every  mark  of  re- 
spect, both  to  the  bodies  and  to  the 
memory  of  those  who  had  suffered  death 
in  its  cause.  They  collected  their  remains 
and  buried  them,  not  only  with  decency, 
but  with  all  the  solemnity  and  honour 
which  circumstances  would  allow  "quibus 
tanquam  organis  et  vasis  ad  omnia  bona 
opera  iisus  est  Spiritus  "  (Aug.  de  Cura  pro 
Mart.  5).  It  was  also  the  custom  for 
Christians  to  hold  their  religious  meetings 
at  the  places  where  their  martyrs  were 
buried,  by  which  they  seemed,  as  it  were, 
united  with  them ;  and  to  display  their 
attachment  to  their  departed  brethren  by 
such  rites  as  were  dictated  by  the  fervour 
of  their  devout  afi^ection,  and  were  con- 
sistent with  the  principles  of  their  religion 
(Ruinart,  Acta  Mart).  It  does  not  appear 
that  this  boundary  was  ever  transgressed 
in  the  three  first  centuries,  and  MabUlon 
owns  that  no  relics  were  set  on  the  altar 
even  to  the  tenth  century  (de  lAturg. 
Oall.  lib.  i.  9,  n.  4).  But  in  the  fourth 
centiu-}^  when  the  pure  and  simple  worship 
of  the  gospel  began  to  be  debased  by  super- 
stitious practices,  we  find  strong  proofs  of 
an  excessive  love  for  everything  which  had 
belonged  to  those  who  had  distinguished 
themselves  by  their  exertions  or  their 
sufferings  for  the  truth  of  Christianity,  and 
especially  for  any  part  of  their  garments, 
hair,  or  bones.  Augustine  in  Africa,  and 
Vigilantius  in  Spain,  complained  loudly  of 
this  culpable  fondness  for  relics,  which  they 
speak  of  as  a  new  corruption,  then  first 
appearing  in  the  Christian  world ;  but  the 
warm  disposition  of  Jerome  led  him  to 
stand  forward  in  their  defence  with  more 
zeal  than  discretion.  However,  this  learned 
Father,  even  while  he  leans  to  the  opinion 
that  miracles  were  sometimes  ■wrought  by 
relics,  explicitly  disclaims  all  idea  of 
offering  them  worship.  But,  when  super- 
stition has  once  made  its  way  into  the 
minds  of  men,  it  gradually  gains  ground ; 


G4S 


RELIGIOUS 


and  it  is  difficult  to  set  limits  to  it,  par- 
ticularlj'-  wlieii  there  is  a  set  of  persons, 
respected  for  their  piet}^  who  are  studious 
to  encourage  it.  Monks  carried  about 
relics ;  and  'with  great  ease,  and  no  small 
advantage  to  themselves,  persuaded  that 
ignorant  age  of  their  value  and  importance. 
Under  their  recommendation  and  patronage, 
they  were  soon  considered  as  the  best  pre- 
servatives against  every  possible  evil  of  soul 
and  body;  and  when  the  worshipping  of 
images  came  to  be  established,  the  en- 
shrining of  relics  was  a  natural  consequence 
of  that  doctrine.  This  led  the  way  to  ab- 
solute worship  of  relics,  which  was  now 
preached  by  the  clergy  of  the  West  and 
of  the -East  as  a  Christian  duty.  Every 
one  thought  it  necessary  to  possess  the  relic 
of  some  saint  or  martyr,  as  the  effectual 
means  of  securing  his  care  and  protection  ; 
and  fraud  and  imposition  did  not  fail  to 
furnish  a  supply  proportionable  to  the 
demand.  The  discovery  of  the  catacombs 
at  Eome  was  an  inexhaustible  source  of 
relics;  and  thus  the  popes  themselves 
became  directly  interested  in  maintaining 
this  superstitious  worship.  The  Council 
of  Trent  authorised  the  adoration  of  relics  ; 
and  they  continue  in  high  esteem  among 
the  Papists  of  the  present  day.  What  has 
been  already  said  is  amply  sufficient  to 
point  out  the  absurdity  of  worshipping  relics. 
It  is  a  doctrine  manifestly  "  grounded  upon 
no  warranty  of  Scripture : "  it  is  "  a  fond 
thing,"  that  is,  foolish  and  trifling,  in  the 
extreme ;  directly  contrary  to  the  practice 
of  the  primitive  Christians,  and  utterly 
irreconcilable  with  common  sense. — Bing- 
ham, xxiii.  4 ;  Tomliue's  El.  Christ.  Theol. ; 
Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  1769. 

RELIGIOUS.  This  was  the  term  as  a 
substantive  word  given  in  our  Chm'ch  be- 
fore the  Reformation  to  persons  engaged  by 
solemn  vows  to  the  monastic  life.  It  is 
still  used  in  this  sense  on  the  Continent, 
and  is  affected  now  by  those  who  are 
members  of  sisterhoods,  &o. 

EEMIGIUS,  or  REMI,  ST. .  Bishop  of 
Reims ;  commemorated  October  1st.  He 
was  born  about  a.d.  439,  and  was  made 
bishop  when  only  22  years  of  age.  He 
converted  Chlodwig  (Clovis),  king  of  the 
Pranks,  and  many  of  his  nobles  and  fol- 
lowers. He  was  afterwards  made  primate 
of  the  Frankish  Church,  and  Reims  has 
ever  since  remained  the  metropolitan  see  of 
France.     [H.] 

REMONSTRANTS  (See  Arminians). 
This  name  was  given  to  the  Arminians 
because  in  1610  they  presented  a  remon- 
strance to  the  States-General  of  Holland 
and  West  Friesland,  specifying  their  griev- 

RENOVATION        Regeneration  is  the 


RENUNCIATION 

work  of  the  Spirit ;  renovation  is  the  joint 
work  of  the  Spirit  and  the  man.  Regenera- 
tion comos  only  once,  in  or  through  bapti^m. 
Renovation  exists  before,  in,  and  after 
baptism,  and  may  be  often  repeated.  Re- 
generation, beins  a  single  act,  can  have  no 
parts,  and  is  incapable  of  increase.  Re- 
novation is,  in  its  very  nature,  progressive. 
Regeneration,  though  suspended  as  to  its 
effects  and  benefits,  cannot  be  totally  lost 
in  the  present  life.  Renovation  may  be 
often  repeated  and  totally  lost.  Dr.  Water- 
land  distingiushes  between  regeneration  and 
renovation  thus : — 

1.  Grown  persons  coming  to  baptism 
properly  qualified,  receive  at  once  the  grace 
of  regeneration  ;  but,  however  well  prepared', 
they  are  not  regenerate  without  baptism. 
Afterwards  renovation  grows  more  and  more 
within  them  by  the  indwelling  of  the 
Spirit. 

2.  As  to  infants,  their  innocence  and  in- 
capacity are  to  them  instead  of  repentance, 
which  they  do  not  want,  and  of  actual  faith, 
which  they  cannot  have:  and  they  are 
capable  of  Ijeing  born  again,  and  adopted  by 
God,  because  they  bring  no  obstacle.  1'hey 
stipulate,  and  the  Holy  Spirit  translates 
them  out  of  a  state  of  nature  into  a  state  of 
grace,  favour,  and  acceptance.  In  their 
case,  regeneration  precedes,  and  renovation 
follows  after,  and  they  are  the  temple  of 
the  Spirit  till  they  defile  themselves  with 
sin. 

3.  As  to  those  who  fall  off  after  regenera- 
tion, their  covenant  state  abides,  but 
without  any  saving  effect,  because  without 
present  renovation:  but  this  saving  effect 
may  be  repaired  and  recovered  by  repent- 
ance. 

4.  With  respect  to  those  who  receive 
baptism  in  a  state  of  hypocrisy  or  impeni- 
tency,  though  this  sacrament  can  only  in- 
crease their  condemnation,  still  pardon  and 
grace  are  conditionally  made  over  to  them, 
and  the  saving  virtue  of  regeneration,  which 
had  been  hitherto  suspended,  takes  effect, 
when  they  truly  repent  and  unfeignedly 
beheve  the  gospel  (See  Eegeneration). 

RENUNCIATION.  In  holy  baptism, 
the  persons  baptized,  or  in  the  case  of  in- 
fants their  sponsors  in  their  name,  are 
asked, "  Dost  thou  renounce  the  devil  and 
all  his  works,  the  vain  pomp  and  gloiy  of 
the  world,  with  all  covetous  desires  of  the 
same,  and  the  carnal  desires  of  the  flesh,  so 
that  thou  wilt  not  follow  nor  be  led  by 
them  ?  "  And  their  answer  is,  "  I  renounce 
them  all.''  This  renunciation  is  of  veiy 
great  antiquity,  so  great  indeed  that  its 
begiiming  cannot  be  traced,  nor  any  time- 
mentioned  when  it  was  not  used;  so  that 
it  is  probably  of  apostolic  origin.- — Bingham, 
vii.,  ii. 


KEPAIES  OF  CHURCHES 

REPAIRS  OP  GHUEOHES.  Anciently 
the  bishops  had  the  whole  tithes  of  the 
diocese ;  a  fourth  part  of  which,  in  every 
parish,  was  to  be  aiDplied  to  the  repairs  of 
the  church ;  but,  upon  a  release  of  his 
interest  to  the  rectors  they  were  acquitted 
of  the  repairs  of  the  churches.  And  by  tlie 
canon  law,  the  repair  of  the  church  belonged 
to  him  who  received  this  fourth  part ;  that 
is,  to  the  rector,  and  not  to  the  parishioners. 
But  custom  (that  is,  the  common  law) 
transfers  the  burden  of  reparation,  at  least 
of  the  nave  of  the  church,  upon  the 
pai-ishioners ;  and  likewise  sometimes  of  the 
chancel,  as  particularly  in  the  city  of 
London  in  many  churches  there.  Generally 
the  rector  is  bound  to  repair  the  chancel. 
Not  because  the  freehold  is  in  him,  for  so 
is  the  freehold  of  the  church  if  he  is  the 
clerical  rector  or  parson  ;  but  by  the  custom 
of  England,  which  has  allotted  the  repairs  of 
the  chancel  to  the  parson,  and  the  repairs  of 
the  church  to  the  parishioners :  yet  so, 
that  if  the  custom  has  been  for  the  parish, 
or  the  estate  of  a  particular  person,  to 
repair  the  chancel,  that  custom  shall  be 
good.  But  the  rector  has  no  more  jjower  to 
make  alterations  in  the  chancel  without  a 
faculty  than  the  vicar  or  churchwardens 
have  in  the  body  of  the  church. 

While  church-rates  were  enforceable,  the 
parishioners  were  bound  to  repair  all  except 
the  chancel,  where  that  belonged  to  a  rector ; 
but  all  that  law  has  now  become  imma- 
terial and  obsolete.  Nothing  has  been  done 
however  to  relieve  rectors  from  their  obliga- 
tion to  repair  chancels,  which  can  be  en- 
forced by  the  spiritual  court.  The  arch- 
deacon may  take  proceedings  against  an  im- 
propriator for  repairs.  Where  there  are 
several  impropriators,  it  is  said  not  to  be 
necessary  to  make  them  all  parties  to  a  suit 
to  make  them  repair  the  chancel,  but  any 
who  receive  great  tithes  may  be  prosecuted. 

By  Canon  86.  "Every  dean,  dean  and 
chapter,  archdeacon,  and  others  which  have 
authority  to  hold  ecclesiastical  visitations 
by  composition,  law,  or  prescription,  shall 
survey  the  churches  of  his  or  their  juris- 
diction once  in  every  three  years,  in  his 
own  person,  or  cause  the  same  to  be  done." 

By  the  statute  of  Circumspecte  agatis 
(13  Edward  I.  st.  iv.),  "  If  prelates  do  pun- 
ish for  that  the  church  is  uncovered,  or  not 
conveniently  decked,  the  spiritual  judge 
shall  have  power  to  take  knowledge,  not- 
withstanding the  king's  prohibition."  But 
this  also  is  superseded  by  the  abolition  of 
compulsory  church-rates,  and  so  is  Canon 
85. 

If  the  churchwardens  or  anybody  else 
wish  to  erect  or  add  anything  new  in  the 
church,  or  to  alter  anything,  as  a  new 
gallery  where  there  was  none  before,  they 


EESERVATION 


64» 


must  have  a  faculty  or  licence  of  the  ordi- 
nary (See  Facvlty). 

REPENTANCE  (Lat.  re  and  pmnitto, 
from  poena,  pain ;  Gr.  waivi) ;  see  Fenitcncc, 
Penance).  A  sincere  sorrow  for  all  past 
transgressions  of  God's  laws,  an  unfeigned 
disposition  of  mind  to  perform  the  will  of 
God  better  for  the  future,  and  an  actiial 
avoiding  and  resisting  of  those  temptations 
to  sin  by  which  we  have  been  overpowered. 

REPROACHES  (See  Creeping  to  the 
Cross).  Hjonns  sung  on  Good  li'riday  while 
the  people  were  prostrate  before  the  cross. 
The  Reproaches  are  an  expansion  of  Micah 
vi.  3,  4  :  "0  my  people,  what  have  I  done 
unto  thee  ?  "  &c.     [H.] 

REQUIEM.  A  musical  mass '  for  the 
dead,  so  called  from  the  words  of  the 
Introit,  "  Requiem  ajternam  dona  eis, 
Domine."     [H.] 

REREDOS  (Fr.  Tarriere  dos ;  called  by 
Bishop  Andrewes  the  backpiece).  A  screen 
behind  an  altar,  of  carved  stone  or  metal 
work,  or  drapery.  It  is  not  earlier  than 
the  fourteenth  century  in  its  later  foiTn, 
nor  under  any  description  previous  to  the 
end  of  the  eleventh  or  beginning  of  the 
twelfth  century.  In  large  conventual 
churches,  where  there  is  a  space  behind  the 
high  altar,  this  was  the  universal  termina- 
tion of  the  ritual  presbytery ;  and  sometimes, 
as  at  AVinchester,  Wells,  St.  Alban's,  York, 
and  Durham,  this  screen  was  of  great  mag- 
nificence. In  smaller  churches,  where  the 
reredos  was  not  required,  the  altar  being  at 
the  extreme  east,  it  is  seldom  found,  though 
an  arcade,  or  other  enrichment  of  the  sjjaco 
beneath  and  at  the  sides  of  the  east 
window,  sometimes  occurs,  as  at  Hanwell, 
Enstone,  Solihull  and  St.  Michael's,  Oxford. 
And  occasionally  the  whole  east  wall  is 
highly  decorated,  as  at  All  Souls,  New,  and 
Magdalene  Colleges,  Oxford,  and  some 
modem  churches.  In  the  Exeter  reredos 
case  {Phillpotts  v.  Boyd),  the  question  of 
the  lawfulness  of  images  in  a  reredos  was 
settled  (See  Images).    [H.] 

EESERVATION  OF  THE  EUCHA- 
RIST. In  very  early  times  this  seems  to 
have  been  common,  in  fact  it  was  un- 
avoidable, owing  to  the  scattered  and  perse- 
cuted state  of  the  members  of  the  Church ; 
hence  Justin  Martyr  says  that  the  eucharistic 
elements  (probably  from  one  central  altar) 
were  sent  to  the  absent  by  the  hands  of  the 
deacons  {Apol.  i.  65)  ;  and  TertuUian  relates 
that  the  priest  gave  them  to  pious  persons 
who  partook  of  them  daily  in  secret,  for  fear 
of  their  enemies,  when  it  was  impossible 
to  hold  religious  assemblies  (^Ad  Ux.  ii.  5  ; 
see  also  Be  Orat.  19).  Several  writers,  as 
St.  Cyprian  and  Eusebius,  speak  of  the 
Eucharist  being  conveyed  to  the  sick  (see 
Communion  of  the  Sick,  III.)  ;  and  indeed 


«50 


RESIDENCE 


such  reservation  seems   to  have  been,  in 
times  of  peace,  intended  only  for  the  sick 
(Bona,  Her.  Liturg.  ii.  17).     The  so-called 
Apostolic     Constitutions     of     the     fourth 
■century  order  the  residue  of  the  elements 
to   he  given  to  the  clergy  in  the  church. 
By  some  councils  it  was  ordered  "  Eucha- 
ristise   gratiam  si  quis  prohatur  acceptam 
iu  ecclesia  non  sumpsisse,  anathema  sit" 
■(CoMC.  Caisar  Aug.  a.d.  381,  c.  iii. ;   Tolet. 
i.  A.D.  398,  u.  14).     The  Council  of  Tours, 
A.D.    566,    under    Pelagius,    required    the 
Lord's  body  to  be  reserved,  on  the  altar, 
not   in  the  aumbry,  but  only  under  the 
cross.    The  practice  of  reservation  was  in- 
tended to  serve  three  purposes :  to  quicken 
the  love  of  the  faithful,  to  have  the  ele- 
ments  ready  for  the  communion,  and  to 
furnish  without  delay  the  communion  of 
the  sick.     Innocent   III.,   in  the  Lateran 
Ojuncil,   1215  (c.   xx.),   ordered  that  the 
Chrism  and  the  Eucharist  in  all  churches 
should    be    reserved  (conserventur)    under 
faithful  guard  and  keep.     In  England  the 
Legatine  Constitutions  at  York  (a.d.  1195) 
require  the  Host  to  be  kept  in  a  clean  and 
comely  pyx,  and   renewed   every  Sunday. 
In   1229   reservation  was  made  for  seven 
days.     Archbishop  Reynolds,  in  1322,  re- 
newed   the    injunction.     Orders  of   other 
English  councils  and  synods  will  be  found 
under  Communion  of  the  SicJc.     The  first 
Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI.  had  a  rubric 
for  the  reservation  "at  open  communion" 
for  the  sick,  which  was  repeated  in  1559, 
but  omitted   at  the  next  revision.      Our 
Articles  (xxv.,  xxviii.)  show  why  the  Re- 
formers deemed  it  necessary    to  disallow 
reservation ;  and  there  is  no  doubt  that  it 
liad   given   rise    to    much    superstition. — • 
Palmer's    Orig.   Liturg.   ii.    229;    Maskell, 
Man.  Eit.  i.  cclxxvii. ;  Walcott's  Sac.  Arch. 
500 ;  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  198,  290.     [H.] 
RESIDENCE.     The  time  during  which 
the  clergy  are  to  reside  on  their  benefices, 
including    cathedi-al    preferments,   is    now 
entirely  regulated  by  statutes,  and  so  it  is 
unnecessary  to  repeat  the  provisions  of  the 
ancient  canon  law,   or    "  the   Queen's  ec- 
clesiastical law"  as  adopted  therefrom,  or 
the  canons  relating  thereto,  or  of  statutes 
which  are  now  repealed  or  superseded.     It 
is  historically  interesting  to    mention  that 
this  matter  was  dealt  with  by  statute  as 
•early  as  21  Hen.  VIII.  c.  13,  which,  among 
other  things,  released  royal  and  peers'   and 
peeresses'  chaplains  from  residence  on  their 
toenefices  during  service  on  their  chaplaincies, 
though  it  is  all  now  repealed,  and   settled 
mainly  by  the  same  Act  as  pluralities,  viz. 
1  &  2  Vict.  c.  106.      By  s.  32  every  in- 
cumbent must  reside  on  his  benefice,  and 
in   the  house  belonging  thereto,  for  nine 
months  in  the  year  unless  he  is  licensed  by 


RESIDENCE 

the  bishop  to  be  absent  longer,  or  to  reside 
out  of  the  parsonage  and  out  of  the  parish 
in  a  house  to  be  specified  ^vithin  three  miles 
of  the  church,  or  two  miles  if  it  be  a 
market  town  or  borough.  And  by  s.  43 
the  bishop  may  give  a  licence  for  entire 
absence  for  the  incumbent's  own  illness  or 
that  of  a  wife  or  child  for  six  months,  renew- 
able only  with  consent  of  the  archbishop, 
or  because  no  convenient  house  can  be  got 
within  the  parish ;  or  finally  (by  s.  44),  for 
any  other  cause  to  be  specified  by  the  bishop 
and  sent  to  the  archbishop.  By  s.  46  all 
such  licences  continue  only  till  the  end  of 
the  year  after  that  in  which  they  are  granted, 
or  therefore  for  two  years  at  the  most ;  but 
they  are  renewable.  And  they  are  re- 
vocable. And  in  all  cases  there  is  an  appeal 
to  the  archbishop  when  they  are  refused  or 
revoked.  These  and  other  clauses  are  as 
usual  loaded  •vdth.  technicalities  of  no  use 
and  not  worth  copying,  and  arc  so  long 
that  we  can  only  give  their  substance  and 
general  effect. 

The  penalties  for  non-residence  of  in- 
cumbents are  by  s.  32 :  for  absence  beyond 
the  three  months  at  any  time  or  times  during 
the  year  and  up  to  six,  forfeiture  of  one  thu'd 
of  the  annual  value  of  the  Uving  :  up  to 
eight  months,  half;  and  beyond  eight 
months,  two  thirds :  and  for  the  whole  year, 
three  fourths.  And  the  bishop  is  authorised 
to  send  every  January  eighteen  questions  to 
every  incumbent,  which  he  is  to  answer  and 
sign ;  and  eleven  more  to  licensed  non- 
resident incumbents  respectmg  their  curates. 
But  the  bishop  may  proceed  by  monition 
instead  of  suing  for  penalties  (s.  54),  and 
sequester  the  living  if  he  disobeys,  and 
apply  the  profits  thereof  to  the  augmentation 
of  the  living  or  repairs  of  the  parsonage  or 
chancel.  He  may  also  remit  the  penalties 
if  he  thinks  fit. 

The  widow  of  an  incumbent  or  canon  may 
keep  his  house  for  two  months  (s.  36). 

A  dean  who  happens  to  have  a  living  (of 
which  there  can  be  very  few  now),  pro- 
fessors in  the  two  old  universities,  chaplains 
of  the  Queen  and  royal  family,  of  bishops, 
and  the  House  of  Commons,  diocesan 
chancellors  (if  clergymen),  archdeacons, 
preachers  of  the  Inns  of  Court  and  the 
Rolls,  the  provost  of  Eton,  warden  of  Win- 
chester, master  of  Charter  House,  principal 
of  King's  College,  London,  and  of  St.  David's 
College,  are  all  exempt  from  residence  on 
their  livings  while  resident  at  or  doing  the 
duties  of  those  respective  offices  (s.  38). 
And  canons  (major  and  minor)  may  reckon 
their  cathedral  residence  as  part  of  their 
residence,  or  any  living,  but  only  to  the 
extent  of  being  absent  five  months  in  the 
year ;  which  practically  docks  them  of  one, 
as  cathedral  residences  are  nearly  all  for 


UESIDBNTIAEY 

tliree  months,  except  that  archdeacon-canons 
are  to  reside  eight  months,  but  the  per- 
formance of  any  archidiaconal  duties  is  to 
count  as  residence  at  the  cathedral ;  and  if 
so,  what  is  the  use  of  requiring  an  archdeacon 
to  reside  longer  than  the  other  canons  at  a 
cathedral  where  he  has  no  special  duties? 
For  archdeacons  have  nothing  to  do  with 
cathedrals,  though  somebody  stuffed  "  arch- 
deaconries" into  the  Act  of  1838  as  "  cathe- 
dral preferment."     [Gr.] 

RESIDENTIARY.  The  capitular  mem- 
bers of  cathedi-als,  who  are  bound  to  re- 
side a  certain  time  at  the  cathedral  church,  to 
IJerform  the  ordinary  duties  there,  and  to 
attend  more  immediately  to  'its  concerns. 
In  England,  all  cathedrals  of  the  old  foun- 
dations bad  residentiaries ,  (canons  residen- 
tiary, as  they  are  called),  and  a  much  larger 
number  of  prebendaries  non-residentiary. 

In  the  new  cathedrals  there  were  no  non- 
residentiary  canons,  and  it  was  intended  by 
the  authors  of  the  great  Cathedral  Reform 
Act  of  1840  that  there  should  be  none  any- 
where. But  during  its  progress  through 
Parliament  it  was  altered  into  merely 
"  suspending  "  the  incomes  of  all  non-resi- 
dentiaries  ;  and  the  residentiaries  were 
reduced  to  four  in  nearly  every  cathedral, 
and  are  appointed  by  the  Crown  or  the 
bishop  in  every  case  if  they  had  been  so 
before ;  whereas  in  several  of  the  old  ones, 
Wells,  Hereford,  and  Chichester,  they  were 
elected,  or  rather,  "called  into  residence," 
by  the  chapter  themselves,  and  at  York 
by  the  dean.  At  Lincoln  and  St.  Paul's  a 
new  residentiary  was  added  to  make  four 
in  the  patronage  of  the  bishop,  but  he  must 
appoint  an  archdeacon  thereto.  The  non- 
residentiaries  however  retain  whatever  an- 
cient rights  they  bad.  But  the  twenty-four 
"  honorary  canons "  who  were  invented  at 
the  same  time  for  the  new  cathedrals  have 
no  rights  of  voting  either  for  proctors  or  the 
disposition  of  chapter  patronage,  or  anything 
else  (See  Cathedral).    [G.] 

RESIGNATION.  I.  A  resignation  is, 
where  a  parson,  vicar,  or  other  beneficed 
clergyman,  voluntarily  gives  up  and  sur- 
renders his  charge  and  preferment  to  those 
from  whom  he  received  the  same. — Deg. 
p.  i.  c.  14. 

11.  That  ordinary  who  hatb  the  power 
of  institution,  hath  power  also  to  accept  of 
a  resignation  made  of  the  same  church  to 
which  he  may  institute ;  and  therefore  the 
respective  bishop,  or  other  person  who, 
either  by  patent  under  him,  or  by  privilege 
or  prescription,  hath  the  power  of  institu- 
tion, are  the  proper  persons  to  whom  a 
resignation  ought  to  be  made.  And  yet  a 
resignation  of  a  deanery  in  the  king's  gift 
may  be  made  to  the  king.  And  some  hold, 
that  the  resignation  may  well  be  made  to  the 


RESIGNATION 


G51 


king  of  a  prebend  that  is  no  donative  ;  but 
others,  on  the  contrary,  have  held,  that  a 
resignation  of  a  prebend  ought  to  be  made 
only  to  the  ordinary  of  the  diocese,  and 
not  to  the  king  as  supreme  ordinary ;  be- 
cause the  king  is  not  bound  to  give  notice 
to  the  patron  (as  the  ordinary  is)  of  the 
resignation ;  nor  can  the  king  make  a  col- 
lation by  himself  without  presenting  to  the 
bishop,  notwithstanding  his  supremacy. — 
2  BolFs  Abr.  358.    Watson,  c.  4. 

But  donatives  are  not  resignable  to  the 
ordinary;  but  to  the  patron,  who  hath 
power  to  admit. — Gibson,  822.  And  if 
there  be  two  patrons  of  a  donative  and  the 
incumbent  resign  to  one  of  them,  it  is  good 
for  the  whole. — Deg.  p.  i.  c.  14. 

III.  Regularly  resignation  must  be  made 
in  person,  and  not  by  proxy.  There  is  in- 
deed a  writ  in  the  register,  entitled,  lifera 
procuratoria  ad  resignandmn,  by  which  the 
iwrson  constituted  proctor  was  enabled  to 
do  all  things  necessary  to  be  done  in  order 
to  an  exchange ;  and,  of  these  things,  re- 
signation was  one.  And  Lyndwood  sup- 
poseth,  that  any  resignation  may  be  made 
by  proctor.  But  in  practice  there  is  no 
way  (as  it  seemeth)  of  resigning,  but  either 
to  do  it  by  personal  appearance  before  the 
ordinary,  or  at  least  to  do  it  elsewhere 
before  a  public  notary,  by  an  instrument 
directed  immediately  to  the  ordinary,  and 
attested  by  the  said  notary ;  in  order  to  be 
presented  to  the  ordinary,  by  such  proper 
hand  as  may  pray  his  acceptance.  In 
which  case  the  person  presenting  the  in- 
strument to  the  ordinary  doth  not  resign 
nomine  procuralorio,  as  proctors  do;  but 
only  presents  the  resignation  of  the  person 
already  made. — Gibson,  822 ;  Deg.  p.  i. 
c.  14;   Watson,  c.  4. 

IV.  A  collateral  condition  may  not  be 
annexed  to  the  resignation,  no  more  than 
an  ordinary  may  admit  upon  condition,  or 
a  judgment  be  confessed  upon  condition, 
which  are  judicial  acts. —  Watson,  c.  4. 

For  the  words  of  resignation  have  always 
been  pure,  sponte,  absolute,  et  simpliciter: 
to  exclude  all  indirect  bargains,  not  only 
for  money,  but  for  other  considerations. 
And  therefore,  in  Gayton's  case,  E.  24 
Eliz.,  where  the  resignation  was  to  the  use 
of  two  persons  therein  named,  and  further 
limited  with  this  condition,  that  if  one  of 
the  two  was  not  admitted  to  the  benefice 
resigned  within  six  months,  the  resignation 
should  be  void  and  of  none  effect;  such 
resignation,  by  reason  of  the  condition, 
was  declared  to  be  absolutely  void. — God. 
277  ;  Gibs.  281 ;  1  Still.  334. 

But  where  the  resignation  is  made  for 
the  sake  of  exchange  only,  there  it  admits 
of  this  condition,  viz.  if  the  exchange  shall 
take  full  effect,  and  not  otherwise ;  as  ap- 


652 


RESIGNATION 


pears  by  the  form  of  resignation,  -which  is 
in  the  register. — Gibson,  821. 

V.  No  resignation  can  be  valid  till  ac- 
cepted by  the  proper  ordinary ;  that  is,  no 
IJerson  appointed  to  a  cure  of  souls  can 
quit  that  cure,  or  discharge  himself  of  it, 
but  upon  good  motives,  to  be  approved  by 
the  superior  who  committed  it  to  him ;  for 
it  may  be  he  would  quit  it  for  money,  or 
to  live  idly,  or  the  like.  And  this  is  the 
law  temporal,  as  well  as  spiritual;  as  ap- 
pears by  that  plain  resolution  which  hath 
been  given,  that  all  presentations  made  to 
benefices  resigned,  before  such  acceptance, 
are  void.  And  there  is  no  pretence  to  say,' 
that  the  ordinary  is  obliged  to  accept ; 
since  the  law  hath  appointed  no  known 
remedy  if  he  will  not  accept,  any  more 
than  if  he  will  not  ordain. — -Gibs.  822 ;  1 
Still.  334. 

Lyndwood  makes  a  distinction  in  this 
case  between  a  cure  of  souls  and  a  sine- 
cure. The  resignation  of  a  sinecure,  he 
thinks,  is  good  immediately,  without  the 
superior's  consent ;  because  none  but  he 
that  resigneth  hath  interest  in  that  case. 
But  where  there  is  a  cure  of  souls  it  is 
otherwise;  because  not  he  only  hath  in- 
terest, but  others  also  unto  whom  he  is 
bound  to  preach  the  word  of  God  ;  where- 
fore in  this  case  it  is  necessary,  that  there 
be  the  ratification  of  the  bishop,  or  of  such 
other  person  as  hath  power  by  right  or 
custom  to  admit  such  resignation. —  Gib- 
son, 823. 

And  in  the  case  of  Heslcet  and  Grey, 
H.  28  Geo.  II.,  where  a  general  bond  of 
resignation  was  put  in  suit,  and  the  de- 
fendant pleaded  that  he  offered  to  resign, 
but  the  ordinary  would  not  accept  the  re- 
signation ;  the  Court  of  King's  Bench  were 
unanimously  of  opinion,  that  the  ordinary 
is  a  judicial  officer,  and  is  intrusted  with 
a  judicial  power  to  accept  or  refuse  a  re- 
signation as  he  thinks  proper;  and  judg- 
ment was  given  for  the  plaintiff. 

VI.  After  acceptance  of  the  resignation, 
lapse  shall  not  run  but  from  the  time  of 
notice  given :  it  is  true  the  church  is  void 
immediately  upoir  acceptance,  and  the  pa- 
tron may  present  if  he  please;  but  as  to 
lapse,  the  general  rule  that  is  here  laid 
down  is  the  unanimous  doctrine  of  all  the 
books.  Insomuch  that  if  the  bishop  who 
accepted  the  resignation  dies  before  notice 
given,  the  six  months  shall  not  commence 
till  notice  is  given,  by  the  guardian  of  the 
spiritualities,  or  by  the  succeeding  bishop; 
with  whom  the  act  of  resignation  is  pre- 
sumed to  remain. —  Gibson,  823. 

VII.  By  the  31  Eliz.  c.  6,  s.  8.  If  any  in- 
cumbent of  any  benefice  with  euro  of  souls 
shall  corruptly  resign  the  same;  or  cor- 
ruptly take  for  or  in  respect  of  the  resign- 


EESIGNATION 

mg  the  same,  directly  or  indirectly,  any 
pension,  sum  of  money,  or  other  benefit 
whatsoever,  as  well  the  giver  as  the  taker 
of  any  such  pension,  sum  of  money,  or  other 
benefit  corruptly,  shall  lose  double  the 
value  of  the  sum  so  given,  taken,  or  had ; 
half  to  the  queen,  and  half  to  him  that  shall 
sue  for  the  same  in  any  of  her  Majesty's 
courts  of  record. 

RESIGNATION  BONDS.  In  conse- 
quence of  the  decision  of  the  House  of 
Lords  in  the  cases  of  Bishop  of  London  v. 
Fytche  in  1780,  against  general  resignation 
bonds,  to  resign  a  living  at  the  request  of 
the  patron,  and  Fletcher  v.  Lord  Sondes  in 
1826,  against  a  bond  to  resign  for  a  particu- 
lar person  (3  Bing.  528),  two  Acts  were 
passed,  one  retrospective,  7  &  8  Geo.  IV.  c. 
25,  and  the  other  prospective,  9  Geo.  IV.  c.  94, 
under  which  bonds  may  be  given  to  resign 
in  favour  of  any  one  person  named  therein, 
or  in  favour  of  two  not  beyond  a  grand- 
nephew  of  the  patron,  or  one  of  several 
patrons  by  either  blood  or  marriage  (not 
including  cousins),  provided  the  patron  is 
not  a  mere  trustee.  The  Act  includes  pre- 
bends by  name,  but  as  s.  6  excludes  all 
official  and  trustee  patrons,  it  is  difficult  to 
see  what  prebends  it  can  apply  to.  These 
bonds  are  generally  put  in  books  under 
Simony,  but  have  nothing  to  do  with  it, 
inasmuch  as  any  money  consideration  would 
vitiate  the  whole  transaction  just  as  much 
as  if  no  bond  were  given.     [G.] 

RESIGNATION  FOR  PENSION.  By 
the  Incumbents  Resignation  Act,  1871  (34 
&  35  Vict.  c.  44),  an  incumbent  during  seven 
years  may  request  the  bishop  to  issue  a 
commission  to  five  persons,  of  whom  the 
applicant  may  nominate  one,  to  inquire 
whether  he  ought  to  resign  for  any  per- 
manent infirmity,  and  (with  the  usual  hea]i 
of  trumpery  technicalities)  they  may  do  so 
and  recommend  that  he  shall  receive  a 
pension  from  his  successor  not  exceeding 
one  third  of  the  annual  value  of  the  bene- 
fice :  which  however  is  not  a  third  of  what- 
ever the  net  receipts  may  be,  but  a  fixed 
sum  which  is  to  be  first  charged  on  the 
living.  Consequently  almost  the  whole  net 
value  in  these  recent  times  in  many  cases 
goes  to  the  ex-cumbent,  atjd  hardly  any- 
thing to  the  in-cumbent.  Besides  wliich,  it 
is  notorious  that  pensions  are  often  awarded 
by  good-natured  neighbours  on  the  com- 
mission to  persons  who  are  in  much  less 
need  of  them  than  their  successors,  and  only 
wanted  an  excuse  for  resigning.  As  some 
clergymen  fancy  they  are  entitled  to  receive 
the  pension  free  from  income-tax  besides,  it 
is  expedient  to  say  here  that  they  are  not, 
by  the  Income-tax  Acts. 

The  Bishops  Resignation  Act,  1869,  is  to 
much  the  same  eifect ;  only  application  may 


RESPOND 

be  made  to  the  Crown  by  an  archbishop  at 
the  request  of  the  bishop  (unless  found 
lunatic),  and  in  the  case  of  an  archbishop 
by  the  archbishop  himself,  or  two  bishops, 
that  he  is  incapacitated  by  permanent 
mental  or  bodily  infirmity ;  and  thereupon 
a  coadjutor  may  be  appointed,  who  is  to 
succeed  on  the  death  of  his  principal,  and 
the  retired  bishop  is  to  have  either  a  third 
of  the  income  or  £2000  a  year,  whichever 
is  greatest,  and  the  latter  nearly  always  is, 
and  tlie  Queen  may  also  assign  him  his  old 
residence  for  life.  When  Bishop  Words- 
worth resigned  in  1885,  he  would  take  no 
pension.  Coadjutor  bishops  existed  in  very 
early  times ;  but  not  one  has  yet  been  ap- 
pointed under  the  Act  (See  Bingham's 
Orig.  Ecc.).    [G.J 

RESPOND :  BESPONSORY.  Before 
the  Reformation  a  short  anthem  was  so 
called,  which  was  sung  after  reading  three 
or  four  verses  of  a  chapter ;  after  which  the 
chapter  proceeded. 

The  responds  were  supposed  to  give  the 
keynote  of  the  lection,  but  frequently  the 
sense  was  broken  up  rather  than  illustrated. 
The  aspect  in  fact  which  the  lectionary  part 
of  the  office  assumed  was  that  of  an  elaborate 
piece  of  music,  interrupted  at  intervals  by  a 
very  brief  recitation  out  of  Holy  Scripture 
as  a  homil}'". — Freeman's  Princ.  Div.  Wors. 
i.  340-1 ;  Palmer's  Orig.  Liturg.  ii.  46 ; 
for  examples  of  responds  see  Proctor,  P.  B. 
184.     [H.] 

RESPOND.  A  half  pillar  attached  to  a 
wall,  to  support  one  side  of  an  arch,  of  which 
the  other  side  rests  on  a  pillar.  It  has  its 
name  from  responding  or  answering  to  a 
pillar. 

RESPONSES.  The  answers  made  by 
the  choir  and  people  after  the  versicles  or 
preces  in  the  Litany  after  the  command- 
ments, &c. 

The  Responses,  or  Pesponsals,  as  some 
writers  call  them,  may  be  said  to  be  of  four 
kinds :  1.  Those  which  consist  of  Amen 
after  the '  prayers.  2.  Those  which  follow 
the  versicles  or  suffrages.  3.  The  short 
prayers  or  anthems,  interposed  between 
each  commandment  in  the  Communion 
Service.  4.  Those  which  are  repetitious  of 
what  the  minister  has  said,  as  in  the  con- 
fession, some  parts  of  the  Litany,  &o.  And 
with  regard  to  those  the  usage  is  not 
uniform;  for  one  sometimes  hears  each 
.sentence  of  the  confession  said  by  the 
minister  and  then  repeated  by  the  people, 
and  sometimes  both  together.  On  the  other 
hand,  the  first  four  sentences  of  the  Litany 
are  always  sung  by  the  choir  distinct  from 
the  minister,  though  he  may  sing  them. 
The  Apostles'  and  Nicene  creeds  are  always 
said  and  sung  continuously,  and  the  minister 
is  scarcely  heard  at  all  in  them. 


EESUREECTION 


053 


The  repeating  the  confession  with  the 
minister  instead  of  after  him  is  no  doubt  an 
irregularity.  The  two  things  are  quite 
distinct,  as  appears  by  the  rubrics.  Those 
parts  which  are  said  ivith  the  minister  are 
the  Lord's  Prayer,  the  Apostles'  creed  and 
Nicene  creed.  Those  which  are  said  after  him 
are  the  general  confession,  and  (by  analogy, 
for  precise  rubrical  directions  are  wanting) 
that  in  the  Communion  Service,  and  the 
prayer,  "  Turn  Thou  us,"  &c.,  in  the  com- 
niination.  "  Each  clause  of  the  confession  is 
marked  by  a  capital  letter  commencing  it . .  . 
and  ought  to  be  repeated  in  each  instance 
when  the  minister  has  paused  "  ( Jebb,  Chor. 
Serv.  p.  250).  Bishop  Cosin  erased  the 
word  "  after"  in  this  rubric,  and  substituted 
"  with  " ;  but  the  original  word  was  care- 
fully restored,  showing  that  a  distinction 
was  intended.  But  as  the  saying  after  the 
minister  was  on  account  of  the  incapability 
of  the  people  to  read,  and  such  a  reason  no 
longer  exists,  the  custom  generally  is  to 
repeat  the  confession  continuously  ivith  the 
minister.     [H.] 

RESPONSORIES  (See  Eespond). 

RESTORATION.  The  name  generally 
given  to  the  return  of  the  lawful  king, 
Charles  IL,  in  1660 ;  and  the  restoration  of 
the  ancient  ecclesiastical  polity,  which  was 
re-established  bj'  the  Act  of  Uniformity  of 
1662,  called  13  &  14  Car.  II.  c.  4,  under 
which  the  intruding  and  unordained  Presby- 
terians and  Independents  who  had  got 
possession  of  church  livings  instead  of  their 
lawful  incumbents,  were  turned  out  again  if 
they  refused  to  conform.  The  Dissenters 
always  talk  of  that  as  an  act  of  tyrann}^, 
and  expect  us  to  forget  that  those  who  were 
so  expelled  were  usurpers  by  whom  the 
lawful  owners  had  been  turned  out,  and 
that  they  were  allowed  to  stay,  if  they 
chose  to  be  ordained,  and  conform  to  the 
old  Liturgy ;  and  that  three  times  as  many 
clergy,  besides  all  the  bishops,  had  been 
ejected  by  their  own  party.     [G.] 

RESURRECTION.  There  are  many 
passages  in  the  Old  Testament,  which  either 
obscurely  hint  at  the  resurrection,  or  im- 
mediately refer  to  it  (Job  xix.  23-27 ; 
Dan.  xii.  2  ;  Isa.  xxv.  8  :  xxvi.  19  ;  Hosea 
vi.  2  :  xiii.  14 ;  Ezek.  xxxvii.  1-14).  It 
follows  indeed  from  the  promise  of  a 
redeemer.  A  redeemer  was  promised  as 
a  blessing  to  Adam  and  the  patriarchs ; 
but  when  Adam  and  the  first  patriarchs 
died,  how  was  the  coming  of  the  Redeemer 
to  be  a  blessing  to  them?  The  answer 
is  given  by  Job :  "  I  know  that  my  Re- 
deemer liveth,  and  that  at  the  latter  daj^ 
he  shall  stand  upon  the  earth ;  whom  I 
shall  see  for  myself,  and  mine  cj'es  shall 
behold;"  i.e.  by  being  raised  from  the 
dead.     The  doctrine  of  the  resurrection  of 


654 


KESUREECTION 


the  dead  is  one  of  the  great  articles  of  the 
Christian  faith.  We  believe  that  Jesus 
died  and  rose  again ;  we  also  believe,  for  so 
we  are  taught  in  the  New  Testament,  that 
"them  which  sleep  in  Jesus  will  God 
bring  with  him,"  that  "  Christ  by  his  rising 
became  the  first  fruits  of  them  that  slept," 
that  "the  dead  shall  be  raised  incorrupt- 
ible," that  "  the  grave  and  the  sea  shall  give 
up  their  dead,"  that  at  this  resurrection 
"  the  dead  in  Christ  shall  rise  first,"  that 
the  Lord  Jesus  Chiist  will  change  "our 
vile  body,  that  it  may  be  fashioned  hke 
imto  his  glorious  body,  according  to  the 
working  whereby  he  is  able  to  subdue  all 
things  to  himself"  (1  Thess.  iv.  14-16; 
1  Cor.  XV.  20-52;  Kev.  xx.  13;  Phil, 
iii.  21). 

As  Christ,  the  "  first  fruits  of  them  that 
slept "  (1  Cor.  XV.  20),  arose  from  the  dead, 
so  shall  there  be  also  a  general  resurrec- 
tion of  the  body ;  for  he  "  that  raised  up 
Christ  from  the  dead  shall  also  quicken  oui' 
mortal  bodies  (Eom.  viii.  11).  A  seem- 
ing difficulty,  however,  attends  the  latter 
case,  which  does  not  the  former.  The  body 
of  Christ  did  not  "  see  corruption  ; "  but  we 
know  that  in  our  case,  "  after  the  skin 
worms  shall  destroy  the  body  itself,"  and 
that  "  yet  in  our  flesh  shall  we  see  God  " 
(Job  xix.  26).  We  must  remember,  how- 
ever, that  Job  had  no  such  clear  revelation 
of  the  nature  of  the  resurrection  as  St. 
Paul.  1  Cor.  XV.  35  to  the  end  is  clearly 
intended  to  refute  the  notion  that  the  same 
flesh  or  particles  of  it  will  form  the  future 
spiritual  body  and  the  present  natural  one. 

And  therefore  it  has  been  prophesied  that, 
notwithstanding  this  destruction  of  the  body, 
yet  in  our  "  flesh  "  (that  is,  in  the  flesh  of 
our  spiritual  body)  shall  we  "  see  God," 
and  our  "eyes  shall  behold  him"  (Job 
xix.  26) ;  that  the  "  dead  men  shall  live," 
and  with  the  "  dead  body,  arise ; "  for 
"the  earth  shall  cast  out  the  dead"  (Isa. 
xxvi.  19),  and  that  they  that  "  sleep  in 
the  dust  of  the  earth  shall  awake,  some 
to  everlasting  life,  and  some  to  shame 
and  everlasting  contempt"  (Dan.  xii.  2), 
so  shall  it  be  accomplished  :  "  there  shall 
be  a  resiurrection  of  the  dead"  (Acts  xxiv. 
15) ;  "  the  hour  is  coming  when  the  dead 
— all  that  are  in  the  grave — shall  hear  the 
voice  of  the  Son  of  God,"  and  "  shall  come 
forth;"  the  "sea"  and  "death  and  hell" 
(or  the  grave)  "  shall  deliver  up  the  dead 
which  are  in  them  "  (Rev.  xx.  13). 

This  our  Lord,  who  calls  himself  "the 
Kesurrection  and  the  Life  "  (St.  John  xi.  25), 
proved  to  the  Sadducees  from  the  Old 
Testament;  since  He  who  was  then  the 
God  of  their  fathers  "is  not  the  God  of 
the  dead,  but  of  the  living  "  (St.  Matt.  xxii. 
32).     St.   Paul   too   confirms  the  doctrine 


EEVELATION 

by  most  powerful  reasoning ;  declaring,  that 
if  there  be  no  resurrection  of  the  dead, 
then  is  "  Christ  not  risen ; "  and  then  is 
their  "  faith "  vain ;  and  he  shows,  in 
answer  to  cavillers,  that,  as  Christ  is  risen, 
"the  first-fruits," — so  shall  "all  be  made 
alive,  exemplifying  the  probability  and  the 
manner  of  this  by  a  familiar  illustration 
(1  Cor.  XV.  12-23,  35-49). 

It  shall  be  too  a  resurrection  of  the 
body,  eveiy  one  his  own  body  as  it "  shall 
please "  God  to  give  him ;  although  the 
"  natural  body,"  "  sown  in  corruption, — 
in  dishonour,- — and  ic  weakness,"  shall  be- 
"raised  a  spiritual  body, — in  incorruption, 
in  glory,  and  in  power."  The  "  earthly 
house  "  shall  have  "  a  building  of  God  "  (2 
Cor.  V.  1) ;  the  "  corruptible "  shall  "  put 
on  incorruption ;  "  and  the  "  mortal,  im- 
mortality." Those  that  do  "not  sleep" 
shall  "be  changed," — "caught  up  in  the 
clouds  to  meet  the  Lord"  (1  Thess.  iv. 
17). 

We  believe  in  this  article,  as  the  great 
truth  it  contains  is  for  the  glory  of  God"s 
eternal  government,  "  the  hand  of  the 
Lord  shall  be  kno^vn  towards  his  servants, 
and  his  indignation  towards  his  enemies" 
(Isa.  Ixvi.  14);  as  it  proves  the  value  of 
the  "  gosjjel,"  which  has  "  brought  life  and 
immortality  to  light "  (2  Tim.  i.  10) ;  as  it 
consoles  us  under  "afflictions,"  which  are 
"  but  for  a  moment : "  since  we  know  that 
our  "  Redeemer  liveth ; "  and  that  we 
"sorrow  not,"  therefore,  "as  others  which 
have  no  hope  "  (1  Thess.  iv.  13,  with  14- 
18)  ;  and  excites  us  "  to  have  always  a  con- 
science void  of  offence  toward  God  and 
toward  men''  (Acts.  xxiv.  16;  mth  15); 
since  "  it  is  a  fearful  thing  to  fall  into  the 
hands  of  the  living  God!  "  (Heb.  x.  31)— 
of  "  him  that  is  able  to  destroy  both  soul 
and  body  in  hell  "  (St.  Matt.  x.  28).  There- 
fore should  we  be  "  always  abounding  in 
the  work  of  the  Lord  ;  forasmuch  as  we 
know  that  our  labour  in  the  Lord  is  not 
in  vain  "  (1  Cor.  xv.  58). 

RETABLE.  A  shelf  or  ledge  behind 
the  altar;  properly  a  part  of  the  reredos. 
On  it  are  placed  the  candlesticks  and  cross. 
It  is  sometimes  called,  but  incorrectlj^  the 
Super-Altar  (See  Super-Altar). 

REVELATION.  I.  The  Divine  com- 
munication of  the  sacred  truths  of  religion 
(See  Bible,  Scripture'). 

11.  The  Apocalypse,  or  prophecy  of  St. 
John,  revealing  future  things.  This  is  the 
last  book  of  Holy  Scripture,  and  it  con- 
tains the  revelations  made  to  St.  John  at 
Patmos.  It  is  quoted  as  an  inspired  book 
by  Justin  Martyr,  Irenasus,  Clement  of 
Alexandria,  TertuUian,  and  other  Fathers 
of  the  first  three  centuries.  Its  authen- 
ticity and  genuineness  were  never  disputed 


KEVEKENCE 

until  a  prejudice  was  excited  against  it  by 
the  follies  of  certain  Millenarians,  who 
thought  to  support  their  conclusions  by  its 
authority.  But  the  Church  never  doubted 
of  its  being  a  portion  of  Scripture,  or  of  its 
Divine  origin.  Indeed,  few  books  of  the 
New  Testament  have  more  complete  evi- 
dence of  canonical  authority  than  the  Book 
of  Revelation.  It  treats,  1.  "  Of  the  things 
which  were  then "  (i.  19),  i.e.  of  the  state 
of  the  Church  in  the  time  of  St.  John ; 
and,  2.  "  Of  things  which  should  be  hero- 
after,"  or  of  the  history  of  the  Church,  its 
propagation,  corruption,  reformation,  and 
triumph.  The  preponderance  of  evidence 
is  greatly  in  favour  of  its  having  been 
written  in  the  time  of  Domitian,  after 
the  destruction  of  Jerusalem.  Its  interpre- 
tation has  been  the  subject  of  too  much 
dispute  to  enter  upon  here.  Even  the 
popish  expositors  admit  that  the  city  on 
seven  hills  means  Eome,  at  one  time  or 
another. 

REVERENCE  (Lat.  rcverentia,  Pr. 
reverer).  Awe  mingled  with  respect  and 
esteem.  Whatever  brings  him  near  to  God 
is  by  the  Christian  regarded  with  reverence, 
such  as  the  Holy  Scriptures,  the  rites  and 
ceremonies  of  the  Church,  the  buildings 
consecrated  to  His  worship.  Especial  reve- 
rence was  always  paid  at  the  reading  of  the 
Gospel  in  the  service  of  the  Eucharist.  In 
the  Eastern  Church  the  book  of  the  Gospels 
is  carried  in  procession  to  the  altar,  the  rite 
being  called  the  "  Little  Entrance,"  as  the 
procession  bearing  the  Elements  to  the 
altar  is  called  the  "  Great  Entrance."  In 
England  formerly  lights  were  burned  on 
either  side  of  the  Gospeller,  to  signify  that 
the  Gospel  is  from  Him  who  is  the  Light  of 
the  world.  This  was  dropped  at  the  Refor- 
mation, as  not  being  a  primitive  usage ;  but 
the  versicle,  "  Glory  be  to  Thee,  0  Lord,"  is 
in  most  churches  sung  after  the  announce- 
ment of  the  Gospel.  It  was  printed  in  the 
earlier  Prayer  Books,  and  is  continued  by 
long  custom.  The  people  also  stand  at  the 
reading  of  the  Gospel.  Sozomen,  the  ec- 
clesiastical historian,  says  that  there  was 
only  one  exception  in  his  time  to  this 
custom,  namely,  that  of  the  bishop  of 
Alexandria.  St.  Chrysostom  refers  to  it 
(Horn.  i.  in  Matt.),  and  in  Apostolical 
Constitutions  (ii.  c.  57)  the  direction  is 
given,  "  When  the  Gospels  are  being  read, 
let  all  the  priests  and  deacons,  and  all  the 
people,  stand  up  in  great  quietness ;  for  it 
is  written,  '  Be  stiU  and  hearken,  0  Israel,' 
and  again,  'But  do  thou  stand  here  and 
listen.'  "■  Hooker,  writing  on  this  custom, 
says,  "  It  showeth  a  reverend  regard  to 
the  Son  of  God  above  all  other  messengers, 
although  speaking  as  from  God  also.  And 
against  all  who  derogate  from  the  honour 


RING 


€55 


of  Jesus  Christ,  such  ceremonies  are  most 
profitable  "  {Ecdes.  Pol.  xxx.  3). 

Archbishop  Laud,  at  a  time  when  reve- 
rence had  dwindled  to  a  minimum,  was- 
accused  of  making  reverence  to  the  East 
on  entering  or  leaving  a  church,  and  in 
certain  ceremonies ;  but  he  denied  that 
reverence  was  paid  to  the  fabric  or  the 
altar,  or  any  such  thing,  but  to  Him  who- 
hath  taken  possession  of  His  house,  and  in 
Whose  honour  all  is  done. — Hook's  ArcJi- 
hishnps,  xi.  195 ;  Blimt's  Annot.  P.  B. 
ii.  169.     [H.] 

REVEREND.  Venerable,  deserving 
reverence  and  respect.  It  is  the  title  given 
to  ecclesiastics  of  the  second  and  third 
orders,  the  archbishops  being  styled  most 
reverend,  and  the  bishops  right  reverend. 
Deans  are  very  reverend,  and  archdeacons- 
venerahle.  In  foreign  churches,  where  females 
are  ordained  to  ofSces  in  the  Church,  ab- 
besses and  prioresses  are  called  reverend 
mothers.  It  was  so  in  our  own  Church 
before  the  Reformation,  but  since  that 
time  the  custom  of  consecrating  females 
to  the  service  of  God,  except  so  far  as  all  lay 
l)ersons  are  so  consecrated  at  holy  baptism 
and  at  confirmation,  has  ceased.  The  more 
zealous  Protestants  at  the  time  of  the- 
Refonnation,  and  especially  during  the 
Great  Rebellion,  very  strongly  objected  to 
the  title  of  reverend,  as  implying  too  much 
to  be  given  to  a  mere  creature,  and  because 
of  God  only  it  may  be  said  with  propriety, 
"  Holy  and  reverend  is  his  name."  But 
dissenting  preachers  are  in  these  days 
ambitious  of  the  title.  The  Privy  Council 
decided  in  Keet  v.  Smith,  1  P.  D.  73,  that 
an  incumbent  cannot  refuse  to  allow  a  dis- 
senting preacher  to  be  called  "reverend" 
on  his  gravestone,  for  that  it  is  not  strictly 
a  clerical  title,  as  was  clearly  proved  from 
history. 

RICHARD,  ST.,  bishop  of  Chichester, 
was  born  at  Wiohe,  in  Worcestershire,  in 
the  thirteenth  century.  He  was  at  one- 
time Professor  of  Civil  Law  at  Bologna. 
In  1245  he  was  appointed  by  the  arch- 
bishop (Boniface)  to  the  see  of  Chichester 
in  opposition  to  Passelew,  the  king's  nomi- 
nee. The  king,  however,  afterwards  gave 
way,  and  St.  Richard,  residing  at  Chichester, 
gained  a  great  reputation  for  his  piety  and 
saintliness.  A  path  up  to  the  cloister  is 
still  called  St.  Richard's  Walk.  Lincoln's 
Inn  Chapel  was  dedicated  to  him.  Com- 
memorated April  3. — Hook's  Archiishops, 
iii.  239 ;  Stephens'  Memorials  of  South 
Saxon  See,  pp.  83-93.     [H.] 

RING,  (1)  ill  Holy  Matrimony.  Im- 
mediately after  the  mutual  promises  in  the 
oflice  of  Matrimony,  the  ceremony  occurs  of 
placing  a  ring  on  the  finger  of  the  woman. 
This  is  of  great  antiquitj^,  and  was   pro- 


656 


KING 


bably  adopted  by  the  early  Christians  from 
the  customs  with  which  they  were  familiar, 
as  having  been  previously  Jews  or  heathens 
(Selden,  Uxor.  Behr.  lib.  ii.  c.  25).  Ter- 
tuUian  speaks  of  the  nuptial  ring  which  the 
husband  had  placed  on  the  matron's  finger 
{Apol.  c.  6 ;  see  also  de  Idol.  c.  16).  St. 
Ambrose  also  speaks  of  the  Annultis  as 
amongst  the  rites  of  espousal  (Ep.  34). 
'I  he  object  of  this  is  stated  in  the  prayer 
following  in  our  service,  to  be  "  a  token  and 
pledge"  of  the  vow  and  covenant  just  made 
by  the  parties.  Kitualists  have  supposed 
that  the  ring  was  also  a  pledge  or  earnest  of 
that  honourable  maintenance  and  partici- 
pation in  "  wordly  goods  "  which  are  pro- 
mised in  that  part  of  the  office  where  the 
ceremony  takes  place.  It  has  also  been 
considered  as  a  sign  or  seal  of  admittance 
of  the  wife  to  "  the  nearest  friendship  and 
highest  trust "  which  it  was  in  the  husband's 
power  to  give.  It  is  probable  that  there  is 
weight  in  all  these  opinions,  though  the 
former  seems  to  be  the  prominent  one  in 
the  view  of  the  Church. 

Various  analogies  and  figurative  appli- 
•cations  have  sprung  from  the  ceremony  of 
the  ring,  some  of  which  may  be  thus  stated. 
The  matter  of  which  this  ring  is  made  is 
gold,  to  signify  how  noble  and  durable  our 
affection  is ;  the  form  is  round,  to  imply 
that  our  respect  shall  never  have  an  end ; 
the  place  of  it  is  on  the  fourth  finger  of  the 
left  hand,  where  the  ancients  thought  was 
a  vein  which  came  directly  from  the  heart, 
and  where  it  may  be  always  in  view  (ac- 
cording to  the  old  rubric,  "quia  in  medio 
•est  quasdam  vena  procedens  usque  ad  cor  ")  ; 
and,  being  a  finger  least  used,  where  it  may 
be  least  subject  to  be  worn  out.  But  the 
main  end  is  to  be  a  visible  and  lasting 
token  and  remembrance  of  this  covenant, 
which  must  never  be  forgotten;  and  if  in 
ordinary  bargains  we  have  some  lasting 
thing  delivered  as  an  earnest  or  pledge  and 
memorial,  much  more  is  it  needful  here ; 
and  to  scruple  a  thing  so  prudent  and  well 
designed,  so  anciently  and  universally  used, 
does  not  deserve  our  serious  consideration. 
Indeed,  although  the  ring  in  marriage  used 
to  be  regarded  as  a  remnant  of  Popery  by 
ultra-Protestants,  it  is  now  universally 
used.  Even  Bucer,  a  man  who  would  bring 
down  any  ceremonies  to  a  minimum,  ap- 
l)roved  of  this  as  "  decent  and  proper " 
(Bucer,  Censur.  p.  488). 

"  Besides  the  pledge  of  our  truth,"  says 
Dean  Comber,  "  there  is  a  visible  pledge 
also — namely,  the  ring,  which  being  an- 
ciently the  seal  by  which  all  orders  were 
signed,  and  all  choice  things  secured,  the 
delivery  of  this  was  a  sign  that  the  party  to 
whom  it  was  given  was  admitted  into  the 
nearest   friendship   and  the  highest  trust, 


EITBS 

so  as  to  be  invested  with  om-  authority, 
and  allowed  to  manage  our  treasure  and 
other  concerns  (Gen.  xli.  42),  and  hence  it 
came  to  be  a  token  of  love  (St.  Luke  xv.  22), 
and  was  used  in  matrimony,  not  only 
among  the  Jews  and  Gentiles,  but  the 
Christians  also,  who,  in  Clemens  Alexan- 
drinus'  time,  gave  their  si»use  a  ring,  to 
declare  her  worthy  of  the  government  of  the 
family;  and  thus  it  hath  been  used  ever 
since  "  (The  reference  is  to  Clem.  Piedagog. 
iii.  c.  11). 

The  ring,  according  to  the  form  in  the 
Sarum  Manual,  was  first  placed  on  the 
thumb  at  the  next  invocation  of  the  First 
Person  of  the  Trinity,  and  on  the  next  finger 
at  the  name  of  the  Second,  on  the  next  at  the 
name  of  the  Third,  and  on  the  fourth  finger 
at  the  word  Amen. — Bingham,  bk.  xxii. 
c.  iii.  5 ;  Wheatly,  p.  42C  ;  Blunt's  Annot. 
P.  B.  ii.  268  (See  Betrothal,  Accustomed 
Duty). 

(2)  In  investitures.  A  ring  was  anciently 
given  to  bishops  on  their  consecration, 
with  these  words,  "Accipe  annulum  dis- 
cretionis  et  honoris  fidei  signum;  ut  quaj 
signanda,  signes;  et  quas  aperienda  sunt, 
aperias;  qua}  liganda  sunt,  liges;  quaj 
solvenda  sunt,  solvas."  It  was  worn  on 
different  fingers,  most  frequently  on  the 
middle  finger  of  the  right  hand ;  and  was  a 
sign  of  the  bridegroom's  espousal  of  the 
Church  in  her  representative,  the  bishop 
(See  Maskell,  Mon.  Bit.  ii.  280,  289). 

Investiture  with  the  ring  and  staff,  which 
signified  a  spiritual  character  and  office,  was 
always  claimed  by  the  Church,  though 
sometimes  \mjustly  usurped  by  temporal 
princes.  It  was  used  also  in  creating 
Doctors  of  Divinity. 

Many  episcopal  rings  are  preserved,  as, 
for  instance,  Athelstan's  in  the  British 
Museum,  Bishop  Gardiner's  at  Winchester, 
three  at  Chichester,  one  with  a  Gnostic  gem 
of  the  twelfth  century ;  two  at  York  of  the 
thirteenth  and  fourteenth  centuries ;  two  at 
Hereford  of  the  fifteenth  century. — Wal- 
oott's  Sac.  Arch.  506.     [H.] 

RITES  (Lat.  ritus).  Religious  ob- 
servances prescribed  by  competent  au- 
thority. Rites  either  directly  appertain  to 
religion,  or  indirectly  refer  to  it.  The 
former  embrace  the  whole  exterior  of  re- 
hgious  worship ;  the  latter  everything,  ex- 
cept direct  worship,  that  is  accounted 
religious  and  proper.  This  part  of  religious 
history  is  very  extensive,  and  can  only  be 
briefly  touched  upon  here. 

In  the  Gospels  and  Epistles  there  are  but 
few  rules  laid  do\\Ti  as  to  ritual  matters. 
In  the  Epistles  there  are  some  general  rules 
given,  that  must  apply  in  a  great  many 
cases ;  such  as,  "  Let  all  things  be  done  to 
edification,  to  order,  and  to  peace"  (Rom. 


KITES 

xiv.  19 ;  1  Cor.  xiv.  40) :  and  in  the 
Epistles  to  IHmothy  and  Titus  many  rules 
are  given  in  such  general  words  as,  "  Lay 
hands  suddenly  on  uo  man,"  that,  in  order 
to  the  guiding  of  particular  cases  by  them, 
many  distinctions  and  specialities  were  to 
be  interposed,  to  making  them  practicable 
and  useful.  In  matters  that  are  merely 
ritual,  the  state  of  mankind  in  different 
climates  and  ages  is  apt  to  vary;  and  the 
same  things,  that  in  one  scene  of  human 
nature  may  look  grave,  and  seem  fit  for  any 
society,  may  in  another  age  look  light,  and 
dissipate  men's  thoughts.  It  is  also  evident 
that  there  is  not  a  system  of  rules  given  in 
the  New  Testament  about  all  these;  and 
yet  a  due  method  in  them  is  necessary,  to 
maintain  the  order  and  decency  that  become 
Divine  things.  This  seems  to  be  a  part  of 
the  gospel  "  liberty,"  that  it  is  not  "  a  law 
of  ordinances  "  (Gal.  ii.  4 :  iv.  9  :  v.  1) ; 
these  things  being  left  to  be  varied  ac- 
cording to  the  diversities  of  mankind  (See 
Artide  34). 

In  the  very  early  ages  of  the  Christian 
Church  each  bishop  was  at  liberty  to  use 
what  indifferent  rites  he  thought  fit  in 
his  own  church,  without  being  account- 
able for  his  practice  to  any  other.  If 
however  they  introduced  anything  that 
might  be  destructive  of  the  truth,  they  were 
obnoxious  to  the  censure  of  all  other  bishops ; 
and  every  individual  of  the  whole  Catholic 
college  of  bishops  was  authorised  to  oppose 
them,  from  which  arose  general  councils. 
Later  on  rites  and  ceremonies  increased  in 
number  and  magnificence,  and  a  new  kind 
of  science  arose,  both  in  the  Bast  and  West, 
the  object  of  which  was  to  investigate  and 
explain  the  grounds  and  reasons  of  the 
sacred  rites ;  and  the  professors  thereof  are 
called  RituaUsts.  From  the  time  of  Gregory 
the  Great,  who  prescribed  a  magnificent 
mode  of  administering  the  Holy  Eucharist, 
called  the  Canon  of  the  Mass,  rites  and 
ceremonies  multiplied,  though  it  was  some 
time  before  the  other  Latin  Churches  could 
be  prevailed  upon  to  adupt  the  Roman  form. 
In  Gaul  the  old  liturgy,  with  its  rites, 
continued  till  the  reign  of  Charles  the 
Great.  In  Spain  the  Mozarabic  was  not 
superseded  by  the  Roman  liturgy  till  the 
thu-teenth  and  following  centuries.  In 
England  the  Ancient  Britons  had  one 
liturgy,  and  the  Angic>-Saxons  received 
another  from  St.  Augustine,  which,  how- 
ever, was  not  precisely  the  Roman.  At  the 
Reformation  those  rites  which  were  deemed 
by  the  Reformers  as  superfluous,  or  tending 
to  superstition,  were  abolished.  "  Some 
were  taken  away,  others  were  retained  for 
discipline  and  order"  (See  Ceremonies, 
Liturgy,  Prayer  Book). — Bingham,  ii.,  vi. 
1 ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  77-81.     [H.] 


RITUALISTS 


657 


RITUAL  (Ritaale).  A  book  or  manual 
in  which  is  sriven  the  order  and  forms  to  be 
observed  in  the  celebration  of  Divine  service, 
the  administration  of  the  sacraments,  and, 
in  general,  all  matters  connected  with  ex- 
ternal order,  in  the  performance  of  sacred 
offices. 

The  English  ritual  resembles  that  of  the 
Eastern  Church  in  the  circumstance  of 
combining  all  the  offices  of  the  Church  in 
one  volume.  The  Euchologium,  or  ritual 
of  the  Greeks,  now  comprises  the  offices  for 
morning  and  evening  prayer,  the  liturgy  or 
Eucharist,  baptism,  litany,  orders,  &c.  The 
Western  Churches  have  more  commonly 
divided  these  offices  into  at  least  four  parts, 
entitled,  the  Brevia<y,  the  Missal  or 
liturgical  book,  the  Ritual,  and  the  Ponti- 
fical. The  ritual  and  pontifical  correspond 
to  that  part  of  the  English  ritual  which 
begins  witli  tlie  Office  of  Baptism.  The 
ritual  (termed  in  the  English  uses  of  Salis- 
bury and  York,  and  elsewhere,  manual,)^ 
comprised  all  those  occasional  offices  of  the 
Church  which  a  presbyter  could  administer. 
The  pontifical  contained  those  only  which  a 
bishop  could  perform. 

The  Euchologium,  or  ritual  of  the  Greek 
Church,  illustrated  with  notes  by  Goar,  is 
well  known  and  easily  accessible,  and 
furnishes  abundant  information  with  regard 
to  all  the  rites  of  the  Catholic  Church  in 
the  East.  The  baptismal  and  some  other 
occasional  offices  of  the  Jacobites  or  Mon- 
nophysites  of  Alexandria,  Antioch,  and 
Armenia,  and  of  the  Nestorians,  have  been 
published  by  Assemani  in  his  "  Codex 
Li,turgicus."  Many  of  the  Oriental  offices 
for  ordination,  as  well  as  all  the  Western, 
are  to  be  found  in  the  learned  treatise  of 
Morinus,  "  De  Ordinationibus."  1'he  most 
valuable  collection  of  records  relative  to 
the  occasional  offices  of  the  Western 
Churches  has  been  published  by  Martene, 
in  his  work,  "De  antiquis  Ecclesias  Riti- 
bus."  This  author,  with  indefatigable  in- 
dustry, transcribed  and  edited  a  multitude 
of  ancient  manuscripts,  and  collected  what- 
ever had  previously  been  published.  So 
that  there  is  scarcely  any  branch  of  ritual 
knowledge  which  he  has  not  greatly  eluci- 
dated.— Palmer,  Ori'j.  Liturg.  ii.  166. 

RITUALISTS,  i.  Those  who  investi- 
gate and  explain  the  grounds  and  reasons  of 
the  sacred  rites :  persons  learned  and  skilled 
in  ritual  (See  Rites.') 

II.  The  name  was  also  given  to  those 
who,  in  a  time  when  there  was  great  care- 
lessness in  carrying  on  the  church  services, 
attempted  to  follow  out  with  exactness  the 
rubrics  of  the  Prayer  Book.  Subse- 
quent "ritualists"  have  gone  beyond  this, 
and  adopted  rites  and  ceremonies  not  re- 
cognised though  not  prohibited  in  the  Prayer 

2  u 


C58 


BITUAliISTS 


Book,  and  some  of  whicli  can  certainly 
be  traced  to  primitive  times  (see  Lights ; 
MixedOIialice;  Vestments).  From  these  prac- 
tices much  controversy  and  many  lawsuits 
have  ensued  (see  Rubric).  In  Martin  v. 
Machonochie,  1868,  it  was  laid  down  by 
the  final  Court  of  Appeal  that  lights  on  the 
altar,  the  use  of  incense,  and  the  mixing  of 
water  with  the  wine  at  the  Holy  Com- 
munion were  illegal.  In  Hebhert  v.  Purchas, 
1871,  the  Judicial  Committee  again  de- 
cided that  the  rites  above  mentioned 
and  the  use  of  vestments  were  illegal. 
As  there  were  great  d£5cultles  in  the 
way  of  a  general  enforcement  of  the  law  as 
laid  down  in  these  judgments,  it  was 
deemed  necessary  to  bring  forward  the 
"  Public  Worship  Regulation  Act "  (q.v.)  to 
provide  a  more  summary  means  of  legal 
procedure.  In  the  face  of  most  powerful 
opposition,  the  Act  passed,  and  came  into 
operation  July  1,  1875.  The  chief  provi- 
sions are — a  representation  may  be  made 
by  .111  archdeacon  or  churchwarden,  or  by 
any  three  parishioners,  or  in  the  case  of  a 
cathedral,  by  any  three  male  inhabitants  of 
the  diocese,  who  sign  a  declaration  that  they 
are  members  of  the  Church  of  England,  and 
who  for  the  previous  year  have  had  their 
abode  in  the  parish  or  diocese,  if  they  are 
of  opinion  (I)  that  any  alteration  in  or 
addition  to  the  fabric  of  the  church  or 
ornaments  has  been  made  without  lawful 
authority ;  (2)  if  the  incumbent  has  used, 
or  permitted  to  be  used,  any  unlawful 
ornament,  or  neglected  to  use  any  prescribed 
ornament  or  vesture ;  (3)  if  he  has  neglected 
to  observe  the  directions  of  the  Prayer  Book 
or  made  (or  permitted)  any  unlawful 
addition  to,  alteration  of,  or  omission  from 
the  services,  rites,  and  ceremonies  thereby 
ordered.  The  "representation"  is  to  be 
sent  to  the  bishop,  who  (unless  he  is  of 
opinion  that  proceedings  should  not  be  taken 
on  the  representation,  in  which  case  he  must 
state  his  reasons  in  writing)  must,  within 
twenty-one  days,  send  a  copy  of  the  re- 
presentation to  the  person  complained  of, 
and  require  both  parties  to  state  in  writing, 
within  twenty-one  days,  whether  they  are 
wilhng  to  submit  to  his  directions  in  the 
naatter  without  appeal.  If  they  consent, 
the  bishop  hears  the  case  and  pronounces 
judgment.  If  not,  the  bishop  sends  the 
representation  to  the  archbishop,  who 
requires  the  judge  specially  appointed  by 
the  Act  to  hear  the  matter.  The  evidence 
is  given  viva  voce  in  open  court,  and  upon 
oath.  The  judge  pronounces  judgment, 
issues  such  monition,  if  any,  and  makes 
such  order  as  to  costs  as  it  may  require. 
An  appeal  lies  to  Her  Majesty  in  council. 
Obedience  by  an  incumbent  to  a  monition 
or  order  of  the  judge  can  be  enforced  by  an 


ROCHET 

order  inhibiting  the  incumbent  from  per-' 
forming  any  service  of  the  church  within 
the  diocese  for  a  term  not  exceeding  three 
months ;  and  after  that  term  the  inhibition 
must  not  be  relaxed  until  the  incumbent 
shall  imdertake  (ia  writing)  to  pay  due 
obedience.  If  the  prohibition  remains  in 
force  for  more  than  three  years,  the  benefice 
becomes  void,  and  it  is  not  lawful  to  present 
the  same  iucumbent  to  it  again.  The 
bishop  may  during  an  inhibition,  unless  he 
is  satisfied  that  due  provision  is  otherwise 
made,  provide  for  the  service  of  the  church, 
and  raise  the  requisite  sum  by  sequestration 
of  the  profits  of  the  benefice. 

Clifton  and  others  v.  Ridsdale,  sometimes 
called  the  Folkestone  Ritual  case,  was  the 
first  important  case  dealt  with  by  the  Act. 
The  charges  were — (1)  use  of  lighted  candles 
at  celebration  of  Holy  Communion;  (2) 
mixing  water  with  the  wine ;  (3)  use  of 
wafer  bread;   (4)  the   eastward  position; 

(5)  kneeling  during  prayer  of  consecration ; 

(6)  singing  the  Agnus  Dei  directly  after 
the  consecration;  (7  and  8)  forming  pro- 
cessions with  acolyths  in  red  cassocks  and 
short  surplices,  banners,  processional  cross 
before  and  during  the  communion,  &c. ;  (9) 
use  of  vestments  called  "  chasuble "  and 
"  alb  " ;  (10)  celebrating  Holy  Communion 
with  less  than  three  receiving;  (11)  erecting 
a  crucifix ;  (12)  having  the  "  stations  of  the 
cross  "  (q.  v.).  Judgment  was  given  against 
all  these  practices.  On  appeal  the  Judicial 
Committee  of  P.  C.  decided  that  the  eastward 
position  is  not  unlawful.  In  the  case  of  the 
Rev.  Sidney  Faithhorn  Green,  incumbent  of 
St.  John,  Miles  Platting,  an  inhibition  was 
served  on  him  after  trial  on  accoxmt  of 
"illegal  practices;"  but  he  refused  to  ac- 
knowledge it,  and  continued  to  officiate. 
After  being  warned  he  was  committed  to 
prison,  and  remained  in  Lancaster  gaol  for 
nineteen  months.     [H.] 

ROCHET  or  POCHETTE  (in  our  Prayer 
Book  Rotchet).  A  linen  garment  worn  by 
bishops  under  the  chimere.  The  word  is 
derived  from  the  Anglo-Saxon  roo  by 
Spelman,  but  by  others  (as  Meursias  and 
Ferrarius)  from  the  German  roch.  It  was 
the  bishops'  ordinary  garment  in  public 
during  the  middle  ages.  The  rochette  is 
spoken  of  in  the  old  "  Ordo  Bomanus,^' 
under  the  title  of  linea ;  and  has,  no  doubt, 
been  very  anciently  used  by  bishops  in  the 
Western  Church.  The  word  Rochette, 
however,  is  not  of  any  great  antiquity,  and 
perhaps  cannot  be  traced  further  back  than 
the  thirteenth  century  (Gavanti,  Thesaur. 
torn.  1,  p.  14:2).  Gavanti  thinks  that  the 
linea  worn  by  St.  Cyprian  was  the  same 
as  the  rochette,  in  which  Baronius  agrees. 
The  chief  difference  between  this  garment 
and  the  surplice  was,  that  it  was  of  finer 


ROGATION  DAYS 

material,  and  that  its  sleeves  were  narrower 
than  those  of  the  latter  ;  for  we  do  not  per- 
ceive in  any  of  the  ancient  pictures  of 
English  bishops  those  very  wide  and  full 
lawn  sleeves  which  are  now  used,  which 
sleeves  are  now  improperly  attached  to  the 
chimere  or  black  satin  robe.  It  differs  also 
from  the  albe  in  reacliing  only  to  the  knees. 

Dr.  Hody  says,  that  in  the  reign  of  Henry 
VIIL,  our  bishops  wore  a  scarlet  garment 
under  the  rochette ;  and  that,  in  the  time 
of  Edward  VJ.,  they  wore  a  scarlet  chimere, 
like  the  doctors'  dress  at  Oxford,  over  the 
rochette ;  which,  in  the  time  of  Queen 
Elizabeth,  was  changed  for  the  black  satin 
chimere  used  at  present. — History  of  Con- 
vocations, p.  141  (See  Chimere). 

The  chimere  seems  to  resemble  the  gar- 
ment used  by  bishops  during  the  middle 
ages,  and  called  mantelletum;  which  was 
a  sort  of  cope,  with  apertures  for  the 
arms  to  pass  through. — Ducange's  Glossary, 
s.  V. ;  Palmer,  Grig.  Liturg.  ii.  407. 

In  some  foreign  cathedrals,  the  canons  wore 
rochets,  as  well  as  other  episcopal  ornaments. 

EOGATION  DAYS  (So  called  from 
rogare,  "  to  beseech ").  They  are  three 
■days  immediately  before  the  festival  of 
Ascension.  These  litany  or  rogation  days 
were  first  instituted  by  Mamertus,  bishop 
■of  Vienne,  in  the  fifth  century.  Mamertus 
was  not  the  originator  of  litanical  suppli- 
cations, but  was  the  first  institutor  of  the 
rogation  fast,  and  the  first  who  applied 
the  use  of  litanies  on  these  days,  accom- 
panied with  public  processions,  which  con- 
tinued till  the  sera  of  the  Reformation 
.(Greg.  Turon.  Hist.  lib.  ii.  34).  The 
rogation  days  of  Mamertus  were  before  long 
received  in  Gaul,  and  afterwards  in  Spain. 
They  were  ordered  to  be  observed  in  the 
English  Church  by  the  Council  of  Clovesho, 
A.D.  747.  But  though  these  three  days 
were  set  apart  for  litanies,  they  were  also 
■celebrated  when  any  particular  circumstance 
rendered  it  desirable  (See  Litany).  It 
was  thought  fit  at  the  Reformation  to 
continue  the  observance  of  these  days  as 
private  fasts.  There  is  no  office,  or  order 
of  prayer,  or  even  single  collect,  appointed 
for  the  rogation  days  in  the  Prayer  Book ; 
but  among  the  homilies  there  is  one 
■designed  for  the  improvement  of  these 
days.  The  requisitions  of  the  Church 
are  "abstinence"  and  "  extraordinary  acts 
and  exercises  of  devotion."  Perambulations 
were  in  many  parishes  observed  in  the 
legation  days  (See  Bounds,  Beating  of; 
Gang-days). 

ROMANISM.  ROMANISTS:  called 
also  Roman  Catholics,  and  sometimes, 
chiefly  by  themselves,  "Catholics,"  but 
the  latter  is  not  a  distinctive  title,  as  they 
have    no  possible   exclusive    claim  to   it. 


ROMANISM 


659 


Christians  who  follow  the  doctrine  and 
discipline  of  the  Church  of  Rome.  The 
doctriue  of  that  Church  may  be  seen  in 
Pope  Pius's  Creed,  and  its  discipline  under 
various  articles  relating  to  the  Christians 
(See  Church  of  Borne,  Popery,  Baptism, 
Eucharist,  &c. ;  Bishops,  Presbyters,  Dea- 

COTIS    &/C   I 

The  Toleration  Act  of  1688,  by  which 
the  Protestant  Dissenters  were  relieved 
from  many  of  the  disabilities  that  pre- 
viously attached  to  them,  procured  no 
change  in  the  position  of  the  Roman 
Catholics.  They  still  remained  subjected 
to  the  penalties  inflicted  by  the  various 
statutes  which,  since  Elizabeth's  accession, 
had  been  passed  for  their  discouragement. 
These  were  exceedingly  severe.  Apart 
from  the  punishments  awarded  for  the 
semi-political  offence  of  denying,  or  re- 
fusing to  admit,  the  sovereign's  supremacy, 
the  Acts  of  Recusancy  (1  Eliz.  c.  2,  and 
23  Eliz.  c.  1)  exposed  them  to  considerable 
fines  for  non-attendance  at  the  seiTice  of 
the  Established  Church;  and  by  other 
statutes  they  were  not  permitted  to  estab- 
lish schools  in  England,  nor  to  send  their 
children  to  be  taught  abroad — they  were 
excluded  from  all  civil  and  military  ofiices, 
from  seats  in  either  House  of  Parliament, 
and  from  the  practice  of  the  law, — they 
were  not  allowed  to  vote  at  parliamentary 
elections, — proselytes  to  Popery,  and  those 
who  were  the  means  of  their  conversion, 
were  subjected  to  the  penalties  of  treason, 
— and,  by  various  oaths  and  tests,  as  well 
as  by  express  provision,  they  were  hindered 
in  the  exercise  of  their  religious  worship, 
and  prevented  from  promulgating  their 
doctrines.  Their  condition  had,  in  fact, 
deteriorated  in  the  reign  of  William  III. 
— some  enactments  of  especial  rigour  being 
sanctioned. 

Whether  from  the  effect  of  these  enact- 
ments, or  from  the  natural  progress  of  the 
principles  of  Protestantism,  it  is  certain 
that  at  this  time  the  number  of  professing 
Roman  Catholics  in  England,  who,  in  the 
reign  of  Elizabeth,  were,  according  to  Mr. 
Butler,  a  majority,  or,  according  to  Mr. 
Hallam,  a  third  of  the  population,  had 
considerably  declined.  But  the  estimates 
of  both  these  writers  were  simply  guesses, 
and  unsupported  by  historical  evidence. 
But  there  seems  no  doubt  that  only  189 
of  the  Marian  clergy  seceded  under  Eliza- 
beth's Act  of  Uniformity,  though  fifteen 
bishops  did,  refusing  to  acknowledge  her 
supremacy :  exactly  the  same  number  as 
were  deprived  by  Mary,  with  the  addition 
that  she  burnt  five  of  them.  A  report 
presented  to  William,  who  was  at  great 
pains  to  find  out  the  proportion  between 
Churchmen,  Dissenters,  and  Papists,  ynth  a 

2  u  2 


660 


EOMANISM 


view  to  reconciling  the  religious  differences 
in  England,  is  as  follows : 


Conformists 

Non-Con- 
formist-. 

Papists. 

Province  of  Canterbury 
Proyincc  of  York    .     . 

2,123,362 
353,892 

93,151 
15,325 

11,878 
1,978 

2,417,254 
2,4J7,254 

108,476 
103,476 

LI, 856 
13,856 

Total  . 

4,954,508 

216,952 

27,712 

The  estimate  was  taken  on  the  adult 
population,  and  an  equal  number  put  down 
for  children  under  sixteen  years  of  age. 
The  total  nearly  agrees  with  the  number  at 
■which  the  population  of  I'".ngland  and  Wales 
was  estimated  at  the  beginning  of  the 
eighteenth  century,  namely,  six  millions 
(Dalrymple's  Memoirs,  app.  to  part  ii.  p. 
14).  Not  much  alteration  in  the  position 
of  the  Koman  Catholics  took  place  for 
nearlj''  a  century  after  the  Eevolution.  As 
the  temper  of  the  times  grew  milder,  many 
of  the  penal  laws  were  not  enforced ;  though, 
while  the  throne  remained  exposed  to  the 
pretensions  of  the  Stuart  family,  the  laws 
themselves  continued  on  the  Statute  Book  : 
indeed,  some  further  measures  were  enacted 
during  the  agitations  consequent  upon  the 
Eebellion  of  1715.  When,  however,  in 
the  person  of  George  III.,  the  Brunswick 
dynasty  was  firmly  settled  on  the  throne, 
a  course  of  mitigating  legislation  was 
commenced,  which  gradually  relieved  the 
Koman  Catholics  from  all  restiaints  upon 
their  worship,  and  from  nearly  all  the  in- 
capacities attached  to  their  religion.  In 
1778,  the  first  remedial  Act  was  passed, 
repealing  the  provision  in  the  10th  and 
12th  of  William  III.,  by  which  the  Koman 
CathoUcs  were  disabled  from  taking  lands 
by  descent.  The  Gordon  riots  of  1780 
rather  aided  than  retarded  the  advance  of 
public  sentiment  towards  additional  relief; 
and,  in  1791,  Mr.  Pitt  (having  obtained 
from  the  chief  continental  universities 
unanimous  opinions  that  the  pope  possessed 
no  civil  authority  in  England,  that  he 
cannot  absolve  the  subjects  of  a  sovereign 
from  their  allegiance,  and  that  the  princi- 
ples of  the  Roman  Catliolic  faith  do  not 
excuse  or  justify  a  breach  of  faith  with 
heretics)  procured  the  passing  of  another 
bill,  by  which,  upon  taking  a  form  of  oath 
prescribed,  the  Koman  Catholics  were  se- 
cured against  most  of  the  penalties  pro- 
nounced by  former  Acts.  They  were  left, 
however,  still  subjected  to  the  Test  and 
Corporation  Acts,  by  which  they  were  ex- 
cluded from  all  civil  and  military  offices, 
were  prohibited  from  sitting  in  either  House 
of    Parliament,    and    were    disabled    from 


EOMANISM 

presenting  to  advowsons.  The  removal  of 
the  chief  of  these  remaining  disabilities  was 
zealously  urged  upon  the  parliament  for  many 
years  successively.  In  1813  an  important 
measure,  framed  with  this  intention,  was 
defeated  in  the  Commons  by  a  majority  of 
only  four ;  while,  in  1821,  a  bill  to  the 
same  effect  passed  through  the  lower  House, 
but  was  rejected  by  the  Peers.  At  length, 
in  1828,  the  Test  and  Coriroration  Acts 
were  abrogated,  and  in  1829  the  Roman 
Catholic  Emancipation  Act  (10  Geo.  IV. 
c.  7)  bestowed  on  Roman  Catholics  sub- 
stantially the  same  amount  of  toleration 
which  was  granted  to  the  Protestant  Dis- 
senters. 

England  had  been  divided  by  Pope 
Innocent  XI.  (probably  in  consequence  of 
the  favourable  attitude  of  James  II.)  into- 
four  districts,  with  a  vicar-apostolic  to 
each.  But,  as  has  been  pointed  out  above, 
Romanism  for  many  years  declined,  though, 
the  arrangement  of  Innocent  remained.  On 
July  20,  1840,  Pope  Gregory  XVI.  re- 
divided  the  four  districts  into  eight,  and 
fourteen  vicars-apostolic  were  appointed  to 
these  between  1840  and  1850.  These 
vicars-apostohc  had  been  consecrated  nomi- 
nally to  dioceses  "in  partibus  infidelium," 
and  bore  such  titles  as  bishops  of  Samosata, 
Ariopolis,  Olena,  &c.  But  imder  the  in- 
stigation and  management  of  Cardinal 
Wiseman,  Pope  Pms  IX.  (Pio  Nono),  ork 
Sept.  29, 1850,  divided  England  into  thirteen 
dioceses  bearing  English  titles.  These  are 
Westminster,  Beverley ,  Birmingham,  Clifton, 
Hexham  and  Newcastle,  Liverpool,  Menevia 
and  Newport,  Northampton,  Nottingham, 
Plymouth,  Salford,  Shrewsbury,  and  South- 
wark.  Cardinal  Wiseman  was  appointed 
the  titular  archbishop  of  Westminster,  and 
was  succeeded  in  1865  by  Henry  Edward 
Manning,  formerly  rector  of  Lavington, 
Sussex,  and  archdeacon  of  Chichester. 
Twenty  years  before,  in  1845,  Manning 
had  declaimed  against  the  intrusion  of  an 
uncanonical  jurisdiction  on  the  British 
Churches,  which  was  clearly  an  act  of 
schism,  and  aggravated  by  every  kind  of 
aggression.  "  It  must  never  be  forgotten," 
he  said,  "  that  the  act  of  the  bishop  of 
Rome,  by  which  a  most  grievous  and  stub- 
bom  contest  was  begun  in  the  English 
Church,  was  taken  not  in  the  character  of 
Patriarch,  but  in  the  title  of  Supreme 
Pontiff.  The  same  Bull  which  made  a  rent 
in  every  English  diocese  professed  also  to 
depose  the  Queen  of  England.  It  was  a 
power  to  give  away  not  sees  only,  but 
thrones  also ;  and  the  effect  of  this  has 
been,  as  in  the  East,  so  in  England,  to 
erect  altar  against  altar,  and  succession 
against  succession.  In  the  formation  of 
sects  in  diocesan  churches,  in  the  exclusive 


EOOD  LOFT 

assumption  of  the  name  Catholics,  in  the 
re-ordiuation.  of  priests,  and  in  restricting 
the  One  Church  to  their  own  Communion, 
there  has  been  no  such  example  of  division 
since  the  schism  of  Donatus"  (Manning's 
Unity  of  the  Church,  364,  2nd  ed.).  Tliis 
division,  or  schism,  as  he  called  it,  the 
Cardinal  Archbishop  of  Westminster  now 
heads.  Including  eleven  coadjutor,  or 
auxihary  bishops,  the  number  of  Komanist 
archbishops  and  bishops  now  holding  nomi- 
nal office  in  the  British  Empire  is  129. 
The  members  in  various  parts  of  Great 
Britain  may  be  computed  at  about 
2,600,000;  in  Ireland  they  numbered  in 
1881, 3,951,888.     [H.] 

EOOD  LOFT  (Old  Bng.  rod:  Sax. 
roda ;  a  gallows  or  cross).  A  gallery 
running  along  the  top  of  the  rood  screen, 
which  in  parish  churches  usually  crossed 
the  chancel  arch,  on  which  the  rood 
(i.e.  the  figure  of  our  Blessed  Lord  on 
the  cross)  was  placed,  and  on  either  side 
the  Blessed  Virgin  and  St.  John.  In  large 
cross  churches,  the  rood  loft  with  its  screen 
was  usually  of  stone,  and  sometimes  con- 
tained a  chapel  and  altar  within  it.  These 
more  substantial  rood  lofts  have  in  many 
cases  been  converted  into  organ  lofts. 

KOOD  SCREKN.  A  screen  separating 
the  chancel  from  the  nave,  on  which  was 
formerly  the  rood  loft,  or  at  least  the  rood. 

BOOF.  The  following  are  the  principal 
terms  which  occur  in  the  description  of  a 
timber  roof. 

Beam. —  A  horizontal  piece  connecting 
the  principals  of  each  truss,  and  stififening 
and  tying  them  together.  According  to 
its  position,  it  is  either  a  tie-beam,  extend- 
ing from  wall  to  wall ;  a  collar-beam,  con- 
necting the  principals  near  the  ridge ;  or  a 
hammer-beam,  extending  horizontally  from 
the  wall  (and  sometimes  again  from  the 
principal  rafters),  but  cut  off  before  it 
reaches  the  opposite  side.  It  is  only  by  its 
combination  with  other  timbers,  as  braces, 
principal,  and  collar,  that  the  hammer- 
beam  serves  the  purpose  of  a  beam  in 
mechanical  construction. 

King-post. — The  middle  post  of  each 
truss,  resting  upon  the  beam,  and  rising  to 
the  ridge.  If  there  is  no  middle  post,  but 
two  dividing  the  wiiole  width  into  three, 
they  are  called  queen-posts. 

Ma/lers. — Timbers  rising  from  the  wall, 
and  inclined  towards  each  other  till  they 
meet  at  the  ridge.  The  principal  rafters 
are  let  into  the  beam  at  their  lower  end, 
and  into  the  king-post  at  their  upper,  and 
together  with  beam,  post,  and  braces,  where 
they  occur,  form  the  trus?,  which  is  the 
whole  complication  of  carpentry,  bearing 
the  vertical  weight  of  the  roof,  and  deliver- 
ing it  upon  the  wall. 


I10SECRUCLA.NS 


CGI 


Purlin. — A  longitudinal  piece  extending 
from  truss  to  truss,  resting  on  the  principal, 
and  bearing  the  common  rafters. 

Braces. — Curved  pieces  tenoned  into  the 
main  timbers  in  various  places  and  direc- 
tions, and  serving  to  stiflen  and  tie  them 
together. 

Wall-plate. — A  longitudinal  piece  laid 
on  the  top  of  the  wall  to  receive  the  beams. 

Wall-piece. — The  upright  piece  connect- 
ing the  braces  beneath  a  hammer-beam 
with  the  wall.  'J'his  subject  may  be  studied 
in  the  valuable  work  of  Mr.  Brandon,  "  On 
the  Open  Timber  Eoofs  of  the  Middle 
Ages." 

ROSARY  (rosarium,  Pr.  rosa,  kindred 
with  poSov).  1.  A  chaplet.  2.  A  string 
of  beads  used  for  numbering  or  counting 
prayers.  There  are  in  the  rosary  five  or 
fifteen  divisions,  each  containing  ten  small 
beads,  and  one  large  one ;  for  each  of  the 
small  beads  an  Ave  Maria,  and  for  each  of 
the  larger  a  Paternoster  is  repeated.  The 
use  of  rosaries  (called  tasbeh,  "  praise ")  is 
common  among  Indian  Mohammedans  ; 
and  in  all  probability  they  were  common 
among  Hindoos  and  Buddhists  long  before 
the  Christian  aira  (Prof.  Monier  Williams, 
quoted  in  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.  ii.  p.  1819). 
But  the  rosary  in  the  Church  of  Rome  is 
of  comparatively  modern  date,  coming  in 
probably  with  the  worship  of  the  Virgin 
Mary.  Some  attribute  its  institution  to 
Dominic,  and  as  such  it  is  mentioned  in  a 
bull  of  Pius  V. ;  but  it  was  in  use  in  the 
year  1100;  and,  therefore,  Dominic  could 
only  make  it  more  celebrated.  Others 
ascribe  it  to  Paulus  Libycus,  others  to  St. 
Benedict,  others  to  Venerable  Bede,  but 
this  was  probably  only  a  play  upon  the 
word  bead,  and  others  to  Peter  the  Hermit. — 
Jo.  Mabillon,  Pre/,  ad  Acta  Sanctor.  Ord. 
Bened.  Siecul.  v.  p.  Iviii.  &c. ;  Stubbs' 
Mosheim,  i.  p.  610. 

BOSECRUCIANS.  A  sect  of  philoso- 
phers in  the  early  part  of  the  seventeenth 
century,  who  combined  much  religious 
error  and  mysticism  with  their  philoso- 
phical notions  of  transmutations,  and  of 
the  chemical  constitution  of  things.  Their 
name  is  derived  from  ros,  "  dew,"  which 
they  held  to  be  the  most  powerful  solvent 
of  gold ;  and  crux,  the  "  cross,"  which  in 
the  chemical  style  signifies  light,  because 
the  figure  of  the  cross  exhibits  at  the 
same  time  the  three  letters  in  the  word 
lux.  Now  light,  according  to  this  sect, 
and  in  their  absurd  jargon,  is  the  men- 
struum of  the  red  dragon,  i.e.  the  sub- 
stance out  of  which  gold  is  produced. 
The  Rosecrucians  then  were  alchemists, 
who  sought  for  the  philosopher's  stone 
by  the  intervention  of  dew  and  of  light. 
These    absurdities    were     associated    with 


CC2 


EOSECEUCIANS 


others  in  their  system  ■\vhioli  it  would  be 
in  vain  to  collect ;  but  the  ruling  principle 
of  their  society  seems  to  have  been  the 
imposing  mystery  in  which  they  wrapped 
up  everything  which  they  knew,  or  pre- 
tended to  know,  as  if  the  secrets  of  nature 
were  made  known  to  them,  for  the  very 
purpose  of  being  kept  secret  from  all 
others. 

At  the  head  of  the  fanatics  were  Eobert 
Fludd,  a  native  of  England,  and  a  man  of 
sm^jrising  genius;  Jacob  Boehme,  a  shoe- 
maker, who  lived  at  Gorlitz;  and  Michael 
Mayer. 

These  leaders  of  the  sect  were  followed 
by  John  Baptist  Helmont,  and  his  son, 
Francis  Mercurius,  Francis  Christian  Knorr, 
of  Eosenroth,  Kuhlman,  NoUius,  Sperber, 
and  many  others  of  various  fame.  An  uni- 
formity of  opinion,  and  a  spirit  of  concord, 
seemed  scarcely  possible  in  such  a  society 
as  this ;  for  as  a  great  part  of  its  doctrine 
is  derived  from  certain  internal  feelings  and 
flights  of  imagination,  which  can  neither 
be  comprehended  nor  defined,  and  is  sup- 
ported by  testimonies  of  the  external  senses, 
whose  reports  are  illusory  and  changeable, 
so  it  is  remarkable  that,  among  the  more 
eminent  writers  of  this  sect,  there  are 
scarcely  any  two  who  adopt  the  same 
tenets  and  sentiments.  There  are,  never- 
theless, some  common  principles  that  are 
generally  embraced,  and  which  serve  as  a 
centre  of  union  to  the  society.  They 
maintain  that  the  dissolution  of  bodies, 
by  the  power  of  fire,  is  the  only  way 
through  which  men  can  arrive  at  true 
wisdom,  and  come  to  discern  the  first 
]3rinciple  of  things.  They  all  acknowledge 
a  certain  analogy  and  harmony  between 
the  powers  of  nature  and  the  doctrines  of 
religion,  and  believe  that  the  Deity  governs 
the  kingdom  of  grace  by  the  same  laws 
with  which  he  rules  the  kingdom  of 
nature ;  and  hence  it  is  that  they  employ 
chemical  denominations  to  express  the 
truths  of  religion.  They  all  hold  that 
there  is  a  sort  of  divine  energy,  or  soul, 
diffused  through  the  frame  of  the  tmiverse, 
which  some  call  Archajus,  others  Universal 
Spirit,  and  which  others  mention  under 
different  appellations.  They  all  talk  in 
the  most  obscure  and  superstitious  manner 
of  what  they  call  the  signatures  of  things, 
of  the  power  of  the  stars  over  all  corporeal 
beings,  and  their  particular  influence  over 
the  human  race,  of  the  efficacy  of  magic, 
and  the  various  species  and  classes  of  de- 
mons. In  fine,  they  all  agree  in  expressing 
the  most  crude,  incomprehensible  notions 
and  ideas,  in  the  strangest  and  most  obscure 
phraseology. — Eenatidot,  Conf.  Pub.  torn.  iv. 
p.  87 ;  Arnold's  Kirclier-  und  Eetzer-llis- 
torie,  pt.  ii.  bk.  xvii.  c.  18 ;  Anth.  Wood's 


EUKAL  DEANS 

Atlienoi  Oxonlens.  vol.  1.  p.  610;  Stubbs' 
Mosheim,  iii.  216-218. 

EOYAL  FAMILY.  The  prayer  for  the 
Eoyal  Family  was  placed  among  the  prayers 
at  the  end  of  the  Litany  by  James  I.  in 
1604.  In  its  present  form  it  was  adopted, 
and  ordered  to  be  used  in  the  Daily  Service 
in  1661.  There  is  a  letter  in  Bishop  Cosin's 
MSS.  from  Charles  II.  to  the  Archbishop  of 
York,  dated  November,  1661,  desiring  that 
this  coUect  should  be  read  in  all  chrn'ohes. 
By  the  Act  of  Uniformity  it  is  enacted  that 
"  in  all  those  prayers,  litanies,  and  collects 
which  do  any  way  relate  to  the  King,  Queen, 
or  Eoyal  Progeny,  the  names  be  altered  and 
changed  from  time  to  time,  and  fitted  to  the 
present  occasion  according  to  the  direction  of 
lawful  authority.  In  the  margin  of  this 
prayer  there  is  a  note  in  Cosin's  book, "  Such 
only  are  to  be  named  as  the  King  shall 
appoint."— Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  i.  27.   [H.] 

EUBRIC  (Fr.  rubrique;  Lat.,  It.,  and 
Sp.  rubrica ;  from  Lat.  rubere,  to  be  red). 
A  direction  printed  in  Service  books,  point- 
ing out  how,  when,  and  where  all  things 
with  regard  to  Divine  service  are  to  bo 
performed.  This  direction  was  formerl}' 
written  or  printed  in  red  ink,  after  the 
example  of  the  old  Eoman  law-books,  in 
which  the  titles  and  remarks  were  so 
written,  hence  the  name.  The  rubrics  are 
now  generally  printed  in  italics ;  and  some- 
times in  red.  All  the  clergy  pledge  them- 
selves to  obey  the  rubrics,  but  there  is 
sometimes  a  difficulty  in  the  interpretation 
thereof.  The  general  rubric  at  the  begin- 
ning of  the  Prayer  Book — "  And  here  it  is 
to  be  noted  that  such  ornaments  of  the 
church,  and  of  the  ministers  thereof,  at  all 
times  of  their  ministration,  shall  be  retained, 
and  be  in  use,  as  were  in  this  Church 
of  England,  by  the  authority  of  Parlia- 
ment, in  the  second  year  of  the  reign  of 
King  Edward  the  Sixth" — has  been  the 
subject  of  much  controversy,  and  though 
the  Dean  of  Arches  and  the  judicial  Com- 
mittee of  the  Privy  Council  have  decided 
several  times  against  the  use  of  such  orna- 
ments as  were  clearly  used  in  1549,  but 
were  prohibited  by  the  Advertisements  of 
Queen  Elizabeth  and  the  Canons,  many 
learned  jjersons  believe  that  those  decisions 
are  contrary  to  the  meaning  of  the  rabrio 
of  1662  (See  Advertisements,  Ornaments, 
Vestinents).    [H.] 

EUEAL  DEANS.  The  office  of  rural 
dean  is  an  ancient  office  of  the  Church, 
which  is  mentioned  as  early  as  the  time  of 
Edward  the  Confessor,  in  one  of  whose 
laws  mention  is  made  of  the  dean  of  the 
bishop  (Decanus  episcopi  in  legg.  Edw. 
Conf.  xxxi.     See  Ducange). 

The  proper  authority  and  jurisdiction  of 
rural  deans,  perhaps,  may  be  best  under- 


RURAL  DEANS 

stood  from  the  oath  of  office  which  in  some 
dioceses  was  anciently  administered  to 
them,  which  was  this :  "  I,  A.  B.,  do 
swear  diligently  and  faithfully  to  execute 
the  office  of  dean  rural  within  the  deanery 
of  D.  First,  I  will  diligently  and  faithfully 
execute,  or  cause  to  be  executed,  all  such 
processes  as  shall  be  directed  unto  me  from 
my  Lord  Bishop  of  C,  or  his  officers  or 
ministers  by  his  authority.  Item,  I  will 
give  diligent  attendance,  by  myself  or  my 
deputy,  at  every  consistory  court,  to  be 
holden  by  the  said  reverend  father  in  God, 
or  his  chancellor,  as  well  to  return  such 
processes  as  shall  be  by  me  or  my  deputy 
executed;  as  also  to  receive  others,  then 
unto  me  to  be  directed.  Item,  I  will  from 
time  to  time,  during  my  said  office,  dili- 
gently inquire,  and  true  information  give 
unto  the  said  reverend  father  in  God,  or  his 
chancellor,  of  all  the  names  of  all  such 
persons  within  the  said  deanery  of  D.,  as 
shall  be  openly  and  publicly  noted  and 
defamed,  or  vehemently  suspected  of  any 
such  crime  or  offianoe  as  is  to  be  punished 
or  reformed  by  the  authority  of  the  said 
court.  Item,  I  will  diligently  inquire,  and 
true  information  give,  of  all  such  persons 
and  their  names,  as  do  administer  any  dead 
man's  goods,  before  they  have  proved  the 
will  of  the  testator,  or  taken  letters  of 
administration  of  the  deceased  intestates. 
Item,  I  will  be  obedient  to  the  right 
reverend  father  in  God,  J.,  bishop  of  C, 
and  his  chancellor,  in  all  honest  and  lawful 
commands;  neither  will  I  attempt,  do,  or 
procure  to  be  done  or  attempted,  anything 
that  shaU  be  prejudicial  to  his  jurisdiction, 
but  will  preserve  and  maintain  the  same 
to  the  uttermost  of  my  power"  (Ood. 
Append.). 

From  this  it  appears  that  besides  their 
duty  concerning  the  execution  of  the 
bishop's  processes,  the  office  of  the  rural 
deans  was  to  inspect  the  lives  and  manners 
of  the  clergy  and  people  within  their 
district,  and  to  report  the  same  to  the 
bishop;  to  which  end,  that  they  might 
have  knowledge  of  the  state  and  condition 
of  their  respective  deaneries,  they  had  a 
power  to  convene  rural  chapters  {Gibson), 
which  chapters  were  made  up  of  all  the 
instituted  clergy,  or  their  curates  as  proxies 
of  them,  and  the  dean  as  president  or  pro- 
locutor. These  were  convened  either  upon 
more  frequent  and  ordinary  occasions,  or  at 
more  solemn  seasons  for  the  greater  and 
more  weighty  affairs.  Those  of  the  former 
sort  were  held  at  first  every  three  weeks,  in 
imitation  of  the  courts  baron,  which  run 
generally  in  this  foim,  from  three  weeks  to 
three  weeks ;  but  afterwards  they  were  most 
commonly  held  once  a  month,  at  the  be- 
ginning of  the  month,  and  were  for  this 


RURAL  DEANS 


6G3 


reason  called  kalenda;,  or  monthly  meetings. 
But  their  most  solemn  and  principal  chap- 
ters were  assembled  once  a  quarter,  in 
which  there  was  to  be  a  more  full  house, 
and  matters  of  greater  import  were  to  be 
here  alone  transacted.  All  rectors  and 
vicars,  or  their  capellani,  were  bound  to 
attend  these  chapters,  and  to  bring  infor- 
mation of  all  irregularities  committed  in 
their  respective  parishes.  If  the  deans 
were  by  sickness  or  urgent  business  de- 
tained from  there  appearing  and  presiding 
in  such  convocations,  they  had  power  to 
constitute  their  subdeans  or  vicegerents. 
The  place  of  holding  these  chapters  was  at 
first  in  any  one  church  within  the  district 
where  the  minister  of  the  place  was  to 
procure  for — that  is,  to  entertain,  the  dean 
and  his  immediate  officers.  But  because,  in 
parishes  that  were  small  and  unfrequented, 
there  was  no  fit  accommodation  to  be  had 
for  so  great  a  concourse  of  people,  therefore, 
in  a  council  at  London  under  Archbishop 
Stratford,  in  the  year  1342,  it  was  ordained 
that  such  chapters  should  not  be  held  in 
any  obscure  village,  but  in  the  larger  or 
more  eminent  parishes  (Kennedy,  Par. 
Ant.  633). 

The  archdeacons  were  frequently  present 
at  these  chapters,  and,  in  effect,  took  the 
presidency  out  of  the  hands  of  the  rural 
deans.  John  of  Athon,  in  Edward  I.'s 
reign,  gives  this  account : — 

"  Rural  chapters,"  he  says,  "  at  this  day 
are  holden  by  the  archdeacon's  officials, 
and  sometimes  by  the  rural  deans."  From 
a  constitution  of  Otho,  ordering  the  arch- 
deacons to  be  present,  we  may  date  the 
decay  of  rural  chapters ;  not  only  as  it  was 
a  discouragement  to  the  rural  dean,  whose 
peculiar  care  the  holding  of  them  had  been ; 
but  also,  as  it  was  natural  for  the  arch- 
deacon and  his  official  to  draw  the  business 
that  had  been  usually  transacted  there,  to 
their  own  visitation,  or,  as  it  is  styled  in 
a  constitution  of  Archbishop  Langton,  to 
their  own  chapter  {Gibson). 

The  office  of  inspecting  and  reporting  the 
manners  of  the  clergy  and  people  rendered 
the  rural  deans  necessary  attendants  on  the 
episcopal  synod  or  general  visitation,  which 
was  held  for  the  same  end  of  inspecting,  in 
order  to  reformation.  In  which  synods  (or 
general  visitation  of  the  whole  diocese  hy 
the  bishop)  the  rural  deans  were  the 
standing  representatives  of  the  rest  of  the 
clergy,  and  were  there  to  deliver  information 
of  abuses  committed  within  their  know- 
ledge, and  to  propose  and  consult  the  best 
methods  of  reformation.  For  the  ancient 
episcopal  synods  (which  were  commonly 
held  once  a  year)  were  composed  of  the 
bishop  as  president,  and  the  deans  of 
cathedrals  or  archpresbyters  in  the  name  of 


CGt 


RUTH 


their  collegiate  body  of  presbyters  or  priests, 
and  the  archdeacons  or  deputies  of  the 
inferior  order  of  deacons,  and  the  urban 
and  rural  deans  in  the  name  of  the  parish 
ministers  within  their  division ;  who  were  to 
have  their  expenses  allowed  to  them  ac- 
cording to  the  time  of  their  attendance,  by 
those  whom  they  represented,  as  the  prac- 
tice obtained  for  the  representatives  of  the 
people  in  the  civil  synods  or  parliament. 
But  this  part  of  their  duty,  which  related 
to  the  information  of  scandals  and  offences, 
in  progress  of  time  devolved  upon  the 
churchwardens ;  and  their  other  office  of 
being  convened  to  sit  as  members  of  pro- 
vincial and  episcopal  synods  was  transferred 
to  two  proctors  or  representatives  of  the 
parochial  clergy  in  every  diocese  to  assemble 
in  convocation,  where  the  cathedral  deans 
and  archdeacons  still  keep  their  ancient 
right,  whilst  the  rural  deans  have  given 
place  to  an  election  of  two  only  for  every 
diocese,  instead  of  one  by-standing  place  for 
every  deanery  {Kennedy). 

At  the  Reformation,  in  the  "  Eeformatio 
Legum,"  it  was  proposed  to  invest  rural 
deans  with  certain  legal  powers,  but  nothing 
was  done  in  this  lespect.  In  the  provincial 
synod  of  convocation,  held  in  London 
April  3,  1571,  it  was  ordained  that  "  the 
archdeacon,  when  he  hath  finished  his 
visitation,  shall  signify  to  the  bishop  what 
clergymen  he  hath  found  in  every  deanery 
so  well  endowed  with  learning  and  judge- 
ment as  to  be  worthy  to  instruct  the  people 
in  sermons,  and  to  rule  and  preside  over 
others ;  out  of  these  the  bishop  may  choo^e 
such  as  he  will  have  to  be  rural  deans " 
(See  Dansey's  Ilorm  Riiri-dccmee'). 

But  the  office  was  not  much  used  till  of 
late  years,  when  it  has  been  revived.  In 
every  diocese  there  are  now  rural  deans 
who  hold  chapters,  generally  once  a  quarter ; 
at  which  are  discussed  matters  sent  i;o  them 
by  the  bishop,  or  sulijects  of  general  interest. 
The  rural  deans  are  appointed  by  the  bishop, 
and  the  appointment  seems  to  be  revocable, 
and  to  require  renewing  by  a  new  bishop. 
The  plan  of  the  clergy  nominating  their 
own  rural  deans  has  lately  been  started  by 
the  Bishop  of  London  (Dr.  Temple). 

RUTH,  THE  BOOK  OF.  A  canonical 
book  of  the  Old  Testament. 

This  book  is  a  kind  of  appendix  to  the 
Book  of  Judges,  and  an  introduction  to  the 
Books  of  Samuel,  and  is  therefore  properly 
placed  between  them.  It  has  its  title  from 
the  person  whose  story  is  the  principal  theme 
<if  the  boik.  The  Jews  make  but  one  book  of 
this  and  the  Book  of  Judges,  and  probably 
the  same  person  was  the  author  of  both. 
It  was  certainly  written  at  a  time  when 
the  government  by  judges  had  ceased, 
since  the  author  of  it  begins  with  observing 


SABBATARIANS 

that  the  fact  came  to  pass  in  the  days 
when  the  judges  ruled:  and  he  ends  his 
book  with  a  genealogy,  vrhich  he  carries 
down  to  David.  Probably  it  was  com- 
posed in  that  king's  time,  before  he  was 
advanced  to  the  throne  (See  Speaker's 
Coramentary). 


s. 

SABAOTH  {(Ta^aiyB).  The  Greek  form  of 
theHebrewword  (DINDS'^  tee Jaoft, signifying 
hosts  or  armies.  Jehovah  Sabaoth  is  the 
Lord  of  Hosts.  "Holy,  holy,  holy,  Lord 
God  of  Sabaoth."  It  occurs  only  twice  in 
the  English  Bible,  Rom.  ix.  29  ;  St.  James 
V.  4.  Dr.  Johnson,  in  the  first  edition  of 
his  Dictionary,  1755,  treated  Sabaoth  and 
Sabbath  as  the  same  word,  and  other  writ- 
ers have  fallen  into  the  same  error.  But 
the  words  have  really  nothing  in  com- 
mon.    [H.] 

SABiiA'i'ARIAKS,  are  so  called  from 
their  keeping  the  seventh  day  of  the  week 
as  the  sabbath;  whilst  Christians  in  ge- 
neral keep  the  first  day  of  the  week,  or 
Sunday,  in  memory  of  our  Saviour's 
having  risen  that  day  from  the  dead.  On 
the  continent  they  are  generally,  but  im- 
properly, called  Israelites.  It  is  uncertain 
when  they  first  made  their  appearance,  but 
we  learn  from  Fuller  that  there  were  Sabba- 
tarians in  1633.  They  object  to  the  reasons 
which  are  generally  alleged  for  keeping  the 
first  day ;  and  they  insist  that  the  change  of 
the  sabbath  from  the  seventh  to  the  first  day 
of  the  week  did  not  take  place  till  the  begin- 
ning of  the  fourth  century,  when  it  was 
effected  by  the  emperor  Constantine,  on  his 
conversion  to  Christianity.  A  summary  of 
their  principles,  as  to  this  article  of  the 
sabbath,  by  which  they  stand  distinguished, 
is  contained  in  the  three  following  propo- 
sitions : — 1.  That  God  has  required  the 
observance  of  the  seventh,  or  last  d;iy  of 
every  week,  to  be  observed  by  manlvind 
universally  for  the  weekly  sabbath.  2. 
That  this  command  of  God  is  perpetually 
binding  on  man  till  time  shall  be  no  more. 
3.  That  this  sacred  rest  of  the  seventh 
day  sabbath  is  not  changed  by  Divine 
authority  frcm  the  seventh  and  last  to  the 
first  day  of  the  week  ;  or,  that  the  Scrip- 
ture nowhere  requires  the  observance  of 
any  other  day  of  the  week  for  the  weekly 
sabbath,  but  the  seventh  day  only,  which 
is  still  kept  by  the  Jews,  to  whom  the  law 
on  this  subject  was  given.  These  are  much 
more  consistent  in  their  rejection  of  all  the 
subsidiary  helps  of  antiquity  in  interpret- 
ing the  Scriptures,  than  those  Protestants 
who  observe  the  first  day  of  the  week  with 


SABBATH 

Judaical  strictness,  wlio  also  are  called  Sab- 
batarians. 

SABBATH  (natt',  from  nnB*,  to  cease  to 
work).  The  day  of  rest.  The  sabbath 
da3%  strictly  speaking,  is  Saturday,  the 
observance  of  which  is  not  considered  ob- 
ligatory by  Christians.  But  the  term  is 
sometimes  applied  to  the  Lord's  day,  which 
is  regarded  as  a  feast  by  the  Church  uni- 
versal (See  Lord's  Day).    [H.] 

SA  BELLI  ANS,  were  so  called  from  Sabel- 
lius,  a  presbyter,  or,  according  to  others,  a 
bishop  of  Libya,  who  was  the  founder  of  tlie 
sect.  Sabellius  flourished  early  in  the  tiiird 
century,  and  his  doctrine  seems  to  have 
had  many  followers  for  a  short  time.  Its 
growth,  however,  was  soon  checked  by  the 
opposition  made  to  it  by  Uionysius,  bishop 
of  Alexandria,  and  the  sentence  of  con- 
demnation pronounced  upon  its  author  by 
Pope  Dionysius,  in  a  council  held  at 
Rome,  A.D.  203. 

Sabellius  tau;^ht  that  there  was  but  one 
person  in  the  Godhead ;  and,  in  con- 
firmation of  this  doctrine,  he  made  use  of 
this  comparison:  as  a  man,  though  com- 
posed of  body  aud  soul,  is  but  one  person, 
so  God,  though  he  is  Father,  Son,  and 
Holy  Ghost,  is  but  one  person.  Hence 
the  Sabellians  reduced  the  three  persons  in 
the  Trinity  to  three  characters  or  relations, 
and  maintained  that  the  Word  and  Holy 
Spirit  are  only  virtues,  emanations,  or 
functions  of  the  Deity ;  that  he  who  is  in 
heaven  is  the  Father  of  all  things;  that 
hie  descended  into  the  Virgin,  became  a  child, 
and  was  born  of  her  as  a  son ;  and  that, 
having  accomplished  the  mystery  of  our 
redemption,  he  difl'used  himself  upon  the 
apostles  in  tongues  of  fire,  and  was  then 
denominated  the  Holy  Ghost. 

Between  the  system  of  Sabellianism  and 
what  is  termed  the  indwelling  scheme, 
there  appears  to  be  a  considerable  resem- 
blance, if  it  be  not  precisely  the  same,  dif- 
ferently explained.  The  indwelling  scheme 
is  chiefly  founded  on  a  false  and  unauthor- 
ised sense  of  that  passage  in  the  New  Tes- 
tament, where  the  apostle,  speaking  of 
Christ,  says,  "  In  Him  dwelleth  all  the 
fulness  of  the  Godhead  bodily."  Dr. 
Watts,  towards  the  close  of  his  life,  adopted 
the  SabeUian  heresy,  and  wrote  several 
pieces  in  its  defence.  His  sentiments  on 
the  Trinity  appear  to  have  been,  that 
"the  Godhead,  the  Deity  itself,  person- 
ally distinguished  as  the  Father,  was 
united  to  the  man  Christ  Jesus,  in  con- 
sequence of  which  union  or  indwelling  of 
the  Godhead  he  became  properly  God." 
Mr.  Palmer  observes  that  Dr.  Watts  con- 
ceived this  union  to  have  subsisted  before 
the  Saviour's  appearance  in  the  flesh,  and 
that  the  human  soul  of  Christ  existed  with 


SACEAMENT 


GG5 


the  Father  from  before  the  foundation  of 
the  world ;  on  which  ground  he  maintains 
the  real  descent  of  Christ  from  heaven  to 
earth,  and  the  whole  scene  of  his  humilia- 
tion, which  he  thought  incompatible  with 
the  common  opinion  concerning  him. — 
Stubbs'  iMosheim,  i.  272  ;  Newman's  transl. 
of  Athanasius,  Orat.  iv. :  contr.  Arian.  xiii. 

SACRAMENT  (See  Baptism;  Holy 
CommiMion  ;  EiKharisf).  In  classical 
writers,  observes  Bishop  Kaye,  in  his  treatise 
on  Tertullian,  the  word  sacramentam  means 
an  oath  or  promise  ratified  by  a  sacred  or 
religious  ceremony  :  thus,  the  oath  taken 
by  the  militairj'  was  called  sacramentum. 
In  strict  conformity  with  this,  its  original 
signification,  it  is  used  to  express  the  pro- 
mise made  by  Christians  in  baptism.  From 
the  oath  the  transition  was  easy  to  the 
ceremony  by  which  it  was  ratified.  Thus 
sacramentum  came  to  signify  any  religious 
ordinance,  and  in  general  to  stand  for  that 
which  in  Greek  is  expressed  by  the  word 
liva-Trjpiov  (mystery),  any  emblematical  no- 
tion of  a  sacred  import,  any  external  act 
having  an  internal  or  secret  meaning. 
Among  the  Fathers  the  word  is  almost 
always  so  used,  and  was  not  restricted  to 
any  particular  number  (Tertull.  adv.  Prax. 
xxviii.  :  de  Anima,  i.  :  de  Bapt.  i.,  xii.  ;  St. 
Cyp.  lie  Orat.  Bom.  ix.,  xxvii. ;  but  St. 
Cyprian  also  uses  the  word  in  connexion 
with  Baptism  and  the  Holy  Eucharist, 
Ej).  Ixx. :  Ixxii.).  If  the  word  is  under- 
stood in  this  extended  sense,  it  seems 
clearly  wrong  to  confine  the  title  to  only 
seven  rites  or  ordinances.  The  first  who 
did  this  was  probably  the  celebrated 
"  Master  of  the  Sentences,"  Peter  Lombard, 
who  died  a.d.  1164  (Lombard,  Sentent. 
lib.  iv.  dist.  ii.).  Certain  it  is  that  the 
number  of  seven  sacraments  was  first 
decreed  by  Eugenius  in  the  fifteenth 
century  (Labbe,  Concil.  xiii.  534),  that  the 
first  provincial  council  which  confirmed  the 
decree  was  one  convened  in  the  sixteenth 
century,  and  that  the  first  council,  even 
pretending  to  be  general,  that  adopted  it 
with  an  anathema  was  the  Council  of 
Trent  (Sess.  vii.  can.  iii.). 

This  is,  in  fact,  the  dispute  of  the 
English  Church  on  this  point  with  Rome. 
If  the  Romanists  take  the  word  sacrament 
in  its  enlarged  sense,  then  they  ought  not 
to  confine  it,  as  they  do,  to  seven  rites  ; 
if  they  take  it  in  its  strict  sense,  then 
they  ought  to  confine  it  to  two.  Baptism 
and  the  Supper  of  the  Lord.  Taking  the 
word  in  its  general  sense,  the  Church  of 
England  directs  the  clergy  to  speak  to  the 
people  of  matrimony  as  a  sacrament.  "  By 
the  like  holy  promise  the  sacrament  of 
matrimony  knitteth  man  and  wife  in  per- 
petual   love,"  &c.   (^Homily  on  Swearing, 


C66 


SACRAMENT 


part  i.).  The  Church  of  England  in  this 
sense  acknowledges  other  rites  to  be  sacra- 
ments besides  Baptism  and  the  Eucharist 
(See  below,  the  extract  from  the  Homily, 
Of  Common  Prayer  and  Sacraments).  This 
is  a  very  important  distinction :  "  Let  it  be 
clearly  understood,"  says  Bishop  Jeremy 
Taylor,  "  it  is  none  of  the  doctrine  of  the 
Church  of  England  that  there  are  two 
sacraments  only,  but  that  of  those  rituals 
commanded  in  Scripture,  which  ecclesiastical 
use  calls  sacraments,  by  a  word  of  art,  two 
only  are  generaXly  necessary  to  salvation^' — 
Taylor's  Dissuasive,  p.  240.  In  like  manner 
Archbishop  Seeker  says,  "As  the  word 
sacrament  is  not  a  Scripture  one,  and  hath 
at  different  times  been  differently  understood, 
our  catechism  doth  not  require  it  to  be  said 
absolutely  that  the  sacraments  are  tivo  only, 
but  two  only  necessary  to  salvation ;  leaving 
jjersons  at  liberty  to  comprehend  more 
things  under  the  name  if  they  please,  pro- 
vided they  insist  not  on  the  necessity  of 
them,  and  of  dignifying  them  with  this 
title." — Seeker's  Lectures,  xxxv..  Of  Bap- 
tism. It  will  be  seen  that  this  is  in  ac- 
cordance with  the  answer  in  the  catechism 
to  the  question.  How  many  sacraments  has 
Christ  ordained  in  his  Church  ?  the  answer 
being  not  simply  two,  but  "  two  only  as 
generally  necessary  to  salvation." 

We  have  said  that  the  distinction  is  im- 
portant, for  it  enables  us  to  take  high 
ground  on  this  doctrine.  It  is  not  by 
depressing  the  other  ordinances  of  the 
Church  which  Cranmer  and  Taylor  call 
sacramentals,  but  by  placing  Baptism  and 
the  Eucharist  in  their  proper  place  and 
dignity,  that  we  best  defend  the  English 
Church  oil  this  point.  If,  with  the  latitudi- 
narians,  we  depress  the  proper  sacraments 
and  make  Baptism  a  mere  ceremony,  and 
the  Eucharist  only  a  more  solemn  form  of 
self-dedication  or  worship,  our  controversy 
becomes  a  childish  dispute  about  words. 
Not  so  if  we  distinguish,  with  the  Church 
of  England,  Baptism  and  the  Eucharist  from 
aU  other  ordinances,  because  they  are,  what 
the  others  are  not,  necessary  for  salvation  to 
all  men,  wherever  they  can  be  had.  Other 
ordinances  may  confer  grace,  but  Baptism 
and  the  Eucharist  alone  unite  with  Christ 
himself.  "By  Baptism  we  receive  Christ 
Jesus,  and  from  him  the  saving  grace  which 
is  proper  to  Baptism ;  by  the  Eucharist  we 
receive  him  also  imparting  therein  himself, 
and  that  grace  which  the  Eucharist  properly 
bestows."  Again;  Baptism  and  the  Eucharist 
are  what  none  of  the  other  ordinances  are, 
federal  rites,  the  one  for  initiating,  the  other 
for  renewing  the  covenant  of  grace,  instituted 
for  a  reciprocal  communion  between  God 
and  man,  of  blessings  on  the  one  part  and 
duty  on  the  other ;  they  are  not  merely  a 


SACEAMENT 

means  to  an  end,  but  they  are  actually  a 
part  of  our  moral  and  Christian  holiness, 
piety,  and  perfection ;  "  as  much  a  part  of 
virtue,"  says  Dr.  Waterland, "  as  the  perfor- 
mance of  any  moral  duty  is,  as  much  as 
feeding  the  hungry,  clothing  the  naked,"  &c. 
From  what  has  loeen  said  it  will  be  seen, 

1.  That,  in  the  large  acceptation  of  the 
word  sacrament,  there  are  many  more  sa- 
craments than  seven. 

2.  That,  in  the  strict  definition  of  the 
word,  there  are  only  two.  Baptism  and  the 
Eucharist. 

But  we  may  sum  up  the  whole  in  the 
words  which  the  Church  of  England  uses 
in  one  of  the  homilies :  "  You  shall  hear 
how  many  sacraments  there  be,  that  were 
instituted  by  om-  Saviour  Christ,  and  are  to 
be  continued,  and  received  of  every  Christian 
in  due  time  and  order,  and  for  such  purpose 
as  our  Saviour  Christ  willed  them  to  be 
received.  And  as  for  the  number  of  them, 
if  they  should  be  considered  according  to 
the  exact  signification  of  a  sacrament, 
namely,  for  visible  signs,  expressly  com- 
manded in  the  New  Testament,  whereunto 
is  annexed  the  promise  of  forgiveness  of  our 
sins,  and  of  our  holiness,  and  joining  in 
Christ,  there  be  but  two,  namely,  Baptism 
and  the  Supper  of  the  Lord.  For,  although 
alsolution  hath  the  promise  of  forgiveness  of 
sin,  yet  by  the  express  word  of  the  New 
Testament  it  hath  not  this  promise  annexed 
and  tied  to  the  visible  sign,  which  is  im- 
position of  hands.  For  this  visible  sign  (I 
mean  laying  on  of  hands)  is  not  expressly 
commanded  in  the  New  Testament  to  be 
used  in  absolution,  as  the  visible  sign  in 
Baptism  and  the  Lord's  Supper  are;  and 
therefore  absolution  is  no  such  sacrament  as 
Baptism  and  the  Communion  are.  And 
though  the  ordering  of  ministers  hath  this 
visible  sign  and  promise,  yet  it  lacks  the 
promise  of  remission  of  sin  as  all  other 
sacraments  besides  the  two  above  named  do. 
Therefore  neither  it,  nor  any  other  sacra- 
ment else,  be  such  sacraments  as  Baptism 
and  the  Communion  are.  But  in  a  general 
acceptation,  the  name  of  a  sacrament  maij 
he  attributed  to  anything  whereby  an  holy 
thing  is  signified.  In  which  understanding 
of  the  word,  the  ancient  writers  have  given 
this  name,  not  only  to  the  other  five,  com- 
monly of  late  years  taken  and  used  for 
supplying  the  number  of  the  seven  sacra- 
ments, but  also  to  divers  and  sundry  other 
ceremonies,  as  to  oil,  washing  of  feet,  and 
such  like,  not  meaning  thereby  to  repute 
them  as  sacraments,  in  the  same  significa- 
tion that  the  two  forenamed  sacraments  are. 
And  therefore  St.  Augustine,  weighing  the 
true  signification  and  exact  meaning  of  the 
word,  writing  to  Januarius,  and  also  in  the 
third  book  of  Christian  doctrine,  affirmeth. 


SAOEAMENTALS 

that  the  sacraments  of  the  Christians,  as 
they  are  most  excellent  in  Bignification,  so 
are  they  most  few  in  number,  and  in  both 
places  maketh  mention  expressly  of  two, 
the  sacrament  of  Baptism  and  the  Supper 
of  the  Lord.  And  although  there  are  re- 
tained by  order  of  tlie  Church  of  England, 
besides  these  two,  certain  other  rites  and 
ceremonies  about  the  institution  of  minis- 
ters in  the  Church,  matrimony,  confirma- 
tion of  children,  by  examining  them  of  their 
knowledge  in  the  articles  of  the  faith,  and 
joining  thereto  the  prayers  of  the  Gliurch 
for  them,  and  likewise  for  the  visitation  of 
the  sick ;  yet  no  man  ought  to  take  these 
for  sacraments  in  such  signification  and 
meaning  as  the  sacraments  of  Baptism  and 
the  Lord's  Supper  are." — Homily  of  Common 
Prayer  and  Sacraments. 

The  article  (25)  against  the  seven  sacra- 
ments runs : — 

"  Sacraments  ordained  by  Christ  be  not 
only  badges  or  tokens  of  Christian  men's 
professions,  but  rather  they  be  certain  sure 
witnesses  and  effectual  signs  of  grace  and 
God's  good  will  towards  us,  by  the  which 
he  doth  work  invisibly  in  us,  and  doth  not 
only  quicken,  but  also  strengthen  and  con- 
firm, our  faith  in  him. 

"  There  are  two  sacraments  ordained  of 
Christ  our  Lord  in  the  gospel;  that  is  to 
say.  Baptism  and  the  Supper  of  the  Lord. 

"  Those  five,  commonly  called  sacraments, 
that  is  to  say,  confirmation,  penance,  orders, 
matrimony,  and  extreme  unction,  are  not  to 
be  counted  for  sacraments  of  the  gospel, 
being  such  as  have  grown,  partly  of  the 
corrupt  following  of  the  apostles,  partly  arc 
states  of  life  allowed  in  the  Scriptures ;  but 
yet  have  not  the  like  nature  of  sacraments 
with  Baptism  and  the  Lord's  Supper,  for 
that  they  have  not  any  visible  sign  or 
ceremony  ordained  of  God. 

"  The  sacraments  were  not  ordained  of 
Christ  to  be  gazed  upon,  or  to  be  carried 
about,  but  that  we  should  duly  use  them. 
And  in  such  only  as  worthily  receive  the 
same  they  have  a  wholesome  effect  or  opera- 
tion :  but  they  that  receive  them  unworthily 
purchase  to  themselves  damnation,  as  the 
apostle  St.  Paul  saith." 

But  though  these  seven  are  called  sacra- 
ments in  the  Eastern  as  well  as  the  Roman 
Church,  they  have  never  been  considered  of 
equal  importance.  In  the  "  Catechism  of 
the  Council  of  Trent "  it  is  said,  "  It  is. 
however,  especially  to  be  noticed  that 
although  all  the  sacraments  possess  a  divine 
and  admirable  efficacy,  yet  all  are  not  of 
equal  necessity  and  dignity,  nor  is  the 
significancy  of  all  one  and  the  same — the 
Eucharist  is  far  superior  to  the  rest  in  holi- 
ness," &c. — Cafech.  Trident,  ii.,  i.  22. 
SACBAMENTALS  (See  Sacrament).  A 


SACEAMENTAEY 


G67 


name  conveniently  given  to  those  rites 
which  are  of  a  sacramental  character, — such 
as  confinnation  and  matrimony, — but  are 
not  sacraments  in  the  proper  and  strict 
sense,  as  Baptism  and  the  holy  Eucharist. — 
Durandus  in  Sent.  lib.  iv.  dist.  2. 

SACEAMENTAIIY,  or  Liber  Sacra- 
mentorum.  Though  some  writers  have 
laid  down  distinctions  between  the  two 
titles,  yet  it  seems  that  they  are  really  sy- 
nonymous, the  latter  being  the  more  ancient 
title.  The  book  was  so  called  (and  also 
sometimes  Liber  Mysteriorum)  because  it 
contained  those  rites  and  prayers  which 
related  immediately  to  the  full  completion 
of  the  sacraments,  and  of  the  Eucharist 
especiallj'.  For  in  these  volumes  were  to 
be  found  the  rites  of  administering  the 
sacrament  of  Baptism  on  the  eves  of  Easter 
and  Pentecost,  of  marriage,  of  orders  of 
reconciling  penitents,  as  well  as  of  the  Holy 
Communion.  As  regarded  the  last,  in  the 
Sacramentary  were  the  collects,  the  secreta, 
the  prefaces,  the  canon,  the  prayer  infra 
canonem,  and  last,  communion  :  in  short,  all 
those  portions  of  the  service  which  were  not 
in  the  other  books.  The  greatest  care  and 
reverence  was  anciently  paid  to  the  Sacra- 
mentary, as  we  may  learn  from  a  canon  of 
the  Council  of  Reims,  cited  by  Georgius 
(torn.  3,  p.  156),  "expleta  missa,  calix  et 
sacramentorum  liber  cum  vestibus  sacerdo- 
talibus  in  mundo  loco  sub  sera  recondantur." 
The  origin  of  the  Sacramentaries  cannot 
be  assigned  to  any  author  later  than  an 
apostle ;  but  they  are  usually  referred  to  and 
known  as  the  Leonine,  the  Gelasiao,  and  the 
Gregorian,  from  Popes  Leo  (a.d.  444-461), 
Gelasius  (492-496),  and  Gregory  (590-604). 
Of  the  first  only  a  fragment  remains,  but 
it  is  supposed  to  be  Leo's  in  a  certain  sense; 
that  is,  to  be  a  series  of  missx  containing 
much  that  he  wrote,  but  also  some  passages 
which  may  be  referred  to  his  predecessors, 
and  some  to  his  immediate  successors,  the 
whole  being  put  together  under  the  pontifi- 
cate of  Felix,  commonly  called  the  thirds 
A.D.  483-492.  Muratori  says  that  though 
we  have  nothing  certain  about  the  author, 
yet  we  may  retain  the  name  of  St.  Leo  the 
Great  (i.  37).  Pameiius  was  the  first  editor 
of  any  part  of  the  Sacramentaries  (the  Gre- 
gorian) :  after  him,  Thomasius ;  but  the 
most  complete  edition  is  that  of  Muratori  in 
1748.  The  Eastern  Churches  have  no  Sacra- 
mentaries, because  they  do  not  employ 
different  prefaces  and  collects  for  different 
days,  but  make  use  of  several  liturgies,  each 
of  which  is  appropriated  to  a  particular 
season  of  the  year.  Very  many  of  our  col- 
lects are  taken  from  these  great  Sacramen- 
taries (See  Collects'). — Maskell,  Men.  Hit. 
Eccl.  Ang.  i.,  Ixii.  ;  Palmer's  Oriy.  Liturg^ 
i.  308 ;  Bright's  Collects,  207,  &c.     [H.] 


668 


SACRIFICE 


S  ACEI FICE.  From  the  beginning  of  the 
world  the  servants  of  God  were  always 
accustomed  to  ofier  sacrifice  to  Him,  by 
way  of  acknowledging  His  sovereignty,  and 
paying  their  homage  to  Him.  In  the  law 
of  natm-e,  and  in  the  law  of  Moses,  there 
was  a  great  variety  of  sacrifices :  some  bloody, 
others  unbloody;  some  were  called  Holo- 
causts, or  whole  burnt  offerings  ;  others  sin 
offerings ;  others  offerings  of  thanksgiving ; 
others  peace  ofierings.  All  these  sacrifices 
of  the  law  of  nature  and  the  law  of  Moses 
were  of  themselves  but  weak  and  feeble 
elements,  and  figures  of  the  great  sacrifice 
■of  Jesus  Christ,  ofiered  afterwards  on  the 
altar  of  the  Cross  for  the  sins  of  the  whole 
world.  It  was  to  renew  the  memory  of  this 
great  sacrifice  of  the  Cross  and  to  apply  the 
fruits  of  it  to  our  souls,  that  our  Lord 
instituted  the  Eucharist ;  for  as  the  ancient 
sacrifices  were  required  to  represent  the 
sacrifice  of  the  Cross,  and  to  prefigure  the 
death  of  Christ,  then  to  come ;  so,  in  like 
maimer,  a  commemorative  sacrifice  was 
required  in  the  new  law  to  be  a  standing 
memorial  of  the  sacrifice  of  the  Cross,  and  to 
represent  the  death  of  Christ  already  past. 

Justin  Martyr  is  the  first  we  meet  with 
who  speaks  of  the  Eucharist  under  the  name 
of  sacrifice  or  sacrifices  {Dial,  cum  Tryp. 
sec.  41 ;  ibid.  sec.  116).  But  he  does  it  so 
often,  and  so  familiarly,  that  one  cannot  but 
conceive  that  it  had  been  in  common  use  for 
some  time  before ;  and  it  is  the  more  likely 
to  have  been  so,  because  oblation  (which  is 
near  akin  to  it)  certainly  was.  He  and  all 
the  other  Fathers  believed  that  the  eucha- 
ristic  sacrifice  was  predicted  and  typically 
represented  by  the  offering  of  Melchisedee. 

L-en«us,  of  the  s-ame  [the  second]  centurj', 
mentions  the  sacrifice  of  the  Eucharist  more 
than  once,  either  directly  or  indirectly 
(lib.  iv.  c.  18).  Tertullian,  not  many  years 
later,  does  the  like  (Ep.  ud  Scapulam,  c.  2). 
Cyprian  also  speaks  of  the  sacrifice  in  the 
Eucharist,  understanding  it  in  one  particular 
passage  ol  the  lay-oblation.  This  is  not  the 
place  to  examine  critically  what  the  ancients 
meant  by  the  sacrifice  or  sacrifices  of  the 
Eucharist.  But,  as  oblation  anciently  was 
understood  sometimes  of  the  lay-ofiering, 
the  same  may  be  obsei  ved  of  sacrifice ;  and 
this  is  plain  from  St.  Cyprian.  Besides  that 
notion  of  sacrifice,  there  was  another,  and  a 
principal  one,  which  was  conceived  to  go 
along  with  theeucharistical  service,  and  that 
was  the  notion  of  spiritu<d  sacrifice,  consist- 
ing of  many  particulars,  and  it  was  on  the 
a.ccount  of  one,  or  both,  that  the  Eucharist 
had  the  name  of  sacrifice  for  the  two  first 
centuries.  But  by  the  middle  of  the  third 
century,  if  not  sooner,  it  began  to  be  called 
a  sacrifice,  on  account  of  the  grand  sacrifice 
represented  and  commemorated  in  it;  the 


SACEIFICE 

sign,  as  such,  now  adopting  the  name  of  the 
thing  signified.  In  short,  the  memorial  at 
length  came  to  be  called  a  sacrifice,  as  well 
as  an  oblation  :  and  it  had  a  double  claim 
to  be  so  called ;  partly  as  it  was  in  itself  a 
spiritual  service  or  sacrifice,  and  partly  as  it 
was  a  representation  and  commemoration  of 
the  high  tremendous  sacrifice  of  Christ 
God-Man.  This  last  view  of  it,  being  of  all 
the  most  awful  and  most  endearing,  came 
by  degrees  to  be  the  most  prevailing  accep- 
tation of  the  Christian  sacrifice,  as  held  forth 
in  the  Eucharist.  But  those  who  styled  the 
Eucharist  a  sacrifice  on  that  account  took 
care,  as  often  as  need  w^s,  to  explain  it  off 
to  a  memorial  of  a  sacrifice,  rather  than  a 
strict  or  proper  sacrifice,  in  that  precise 
view.  Cyprian  is  the  first  who  plainly  and 
directly  styles  the  Eucharist  a  sacrifice  in 
the  commemorative  view,  and  as  representing 
the  grand  sacrifice.  Not  that  there  was 
anything  new  in  the  doctrine,  but  there  was 
a  new  application  of  an  old  name,  which 
had  at  the  first  been  brought  in  upon  other 
accounts. 

II.  The  Church  of  England  has  always 
acknowledged  such  a  sacrifice.  The  31st 
article  is  directed  against  the  vulgar  and 
heretical  doctrine  of  the  reiteration  of 
Christ's  sacrifice  in  the  Eucharist.  The 
article  was  directed  against  the  errors  main- 
tained by  .such  men  as  Soto,  Hardinge,  &c., 
who,  by  rejecting  the  doctrine  of  a  sacrifice 
by  way  of  commemoration  and  consecration, 
and  not  literally  identical  with  that  on  the 
cross,  and  by  their  crude  and  objectionable 
mode  of  expression,  countenanced  the  vulgar 
error,  that  the  sacrifice  of  the  Eucharist  or 
mass,  was  in  every  respect  equal  to  that  of 
Christ  on  the  cross  ;  and  that  it  was  in  fact 
either  a  reiteration  or  a  continuation  of  that 
sacrifice.  The  article  was  not  against  the 
doctrine  of  the  eucharistic  sacrifice  as  ex- 
plained by  Bossuet,  Beron,  and  others,  with 
which  we  have  no  material  fault  to  find. 
Cranmer  himself  said  that  it  might  be  called 
a  sacrifice  (Works,  by  Jenkyns,  vol.  iii. 
pp.  5,  161,  539,  551),  and  our  theologians, 
such  as  Bramhall,  Beveridge,  Patrick,  Wil- 
son, bishops ;  and  Mason  Field,  Mede,  John- 
son, &c.,  have  always  taught  the  doctrine 
of  the  eucharistic  altar,  sacrifice,  and  obla- 
tion, according  to  Scripture  and  apostolical 
tradition;  and  the  articles  of  the  Church 
of  England  recognise  the  clergy  in  their 
various  orders,  as  sacerdoies,  ministers  of 
sacrifice.     [H.] 

III.  Many  writers  call  the  Eucharist  an 
unbloody  sacrifice,  because  (1)  it  is  a  com- 
memoration and  a  representation  to  G-od,  of 
the  sacrifice  that  Christ  offered  for  us  on  the 
cross ;  in  which  we  lay  claim  to  that  as  to 
our  expiation,  and  feast  upon  it  as  our 
peace-offering,    according    to  that  ancient 


SACRIFICE 

notion,  that  covenants  were  by  a  sacrifice, 
and  were  concluded  in  a  feast  on  the  sacrifice. 
The  priest's  action  in  offerinp;  our  Christian 
sacrifice  may  be  described  (a)  as  tlie  earthly 
counterpart  of  that  whicli  Christ  continually 
does  in  heaven :  O)  as  the  commemoration 
of  that  which  once  for  all  He  did  on  Cal- 
vary. (2)  There  is  an  oblation  of  bread  and 
wine  made  in  it,  which  lieing  sanctified,  are 
consumed  in  an  act  of  religion :  to  tliis 
many  passages  in  the  writings  of  the  Fathers 
relate.  (3)  We  then  offer  up  "  ourselves, 
our  souls  and  bodies,  to  be  a  reasonable,  holy 
and  lively  sacrifice  unto  God."  It  is  the 
"  pure  offering  "  spoken  of  by  Malachi,  i.  11. 

"  Under  this  name  of  the  Christian  sacri- 
fice," says  Joseph  Mede,  "  first  know,  that 
the  ancient  Church  understood  not,  as  many 
suppose,  the  mere  sacrament  of  the  body 
and  blood  of  Christ,  but  the  whole  sacred 
action  or  solemn  service  of  the  Church  as- 
sembled, whereof  this  sacred  mystery  was 
then  a  prime  and  principal  part,  and,  as  it 
were,  the  pearl  or  jewel  of  this  ring,  no 
public  service  of  the  Church  being  without 
it.  This  observed  and  remembered,  I  define 
the  Christian  sacrifice,  ex  mente  antiqum 
ecdesiai,  in  this  maimer :  An  oblation  of 
thanksgiving  and  prayer  to  Grod  the  Father 
through  Jfsus  Christ,  and  His  sacrifice  com- 
memorated in  the  creatures  of  bread  and 
wine,  wherewith  God  had  first  been  agnized. 
So  that  this  sacrifice,  as  you  see,  hath  a 
double  object,  or  matter;  first,  praise  and 
prayer,  which  you  may  c-ill  sacrificium  quod, 
secondly,  the  commemoration  of  Christ's 
sacrifice  on  the  cross,  which  is  sacrificium 
quo,  the  sacrifice  whereby  the  other  is  ac- 
cepted. For  all  the  prayers,  thanksgivings, 
and  devotions  of  a  Christian  are  tendered  up 
unto  God  in  the  name  of  Jesus  Christ  cruci- 
fied. According  whereunto  we  are  wont  to 
conclude  our  prayers  with  "  through  Jesus 
Christ  our  Lord."  And  this  is  the  specifi- 
cation whereby  the  worship  of  a  Christian 
is  distinguished  from  that  of  the  Jew. 
Now  that  which  we,  in  all  our  prayers  and 
thanksgivings,  do  vocally,  when  we  say  per 
lesum  Christum  Bominum  nostrum,  the 
ancient  Church,  in  her  public  and  solemn 
service,  did  visibly  by  representing  Him, 
according  as  He  commanded,  in  the  symbols 
of  His  body  and  blood:  for  there  He  is  com- 
memorated and  received  by  us  for  the  same 
end  for  which  He  was  given  and  suffered  for 
us ;  that  through  Him  we  receiving  forgive- 
ness of  our  sins,  God  our  Father  might 
accept  our  service  and  hear  our  prayers  we 
make  unto  Him." 

"  What  time  then  so  fit  and  seasonable  to 
commend  our  devotions  unto  God,  as  when 
the  Lamb  of  God  lies  slain  upon  the  holy 
table,  and  we  receive  visibly,  though  mys- 
tically, those  gracious  pledges  of  His  blessed 


SACRIFIOATI 


GG9 


body  and  blood.  This  was  that  sacrifice 
of  the  ancient  Church,  which  the  Fathers 
so  much  ring  in  our  ears.  The  sacrifice 
of  praise  and  prayer  through  Jesus  Christ, 
mystically  represented  in  the  creatures  of 
bread  and  wine." 

"  But  yet  there  is  one  thing  more  my  defi- 
nition intimates,  when  I  say  '  through  the 
sacrifice  of  Jesus  Christ,  commem^irated  in 
the  creatures  of  bread  and  wine,  wherewith 
God  had  first  been  agnized.'  The  body  and 
blood  of  Christ  were  not  made  of  common 
bread  and  common  -wine,  but  of  bread  and 
wine  first  sanctified  by  being  offered  and  set 
before  God  as  a  present,  to  agnize  Him  the 
Lord  and  giver  of  all :  according  to  that 
Domini  est  terra  et  plenitudo  e)us :  and  '  let 
no  man  appear  be'bre  the  Lord  empty.' 
Therefore,  as  this  sacrifice  consisted  of  two 
parts,  as  I  told  you,  of  praise  and  prayer, 
which  in  respect  of  the  other,  I  call  sacri- 
ficium quod  ;  and  of  the  commemoration  of 
Christ  crucified,  which  I  call  sacrificium 
quo  ;  so  the  symbols  of  bread  and  wine 
traversed  both,  being  first  presented  as 
symbols  of  praise  and  thanksgiving  to 
agnize  God  the  Lord  of  the  creature  in  the 
sacrificium  quod ;  then,  by  invocation  of 
the  Holy  Ghost,  made  the  symbols  of  the 
body  and  blood  of  Christ  in  the  sacrificium 
quo.  So  that  the  whole  service  throughout 
consisted  of  a  reasonable  part  and  of  a  ma- 
terial part,  as  of  a  soul  and  a  body ;  of 
which  I  shall  speak  more  fully  hereafter, 
when  I  come  to  prove  this,  I  have  said,  by 
the  testimonies  of  the  ancients  ...  To 
hold  you,  therefore,  no  longer  in  suspense, 
a  sacrifice,  I  think,  should  be  defined 
thus :  an  offering,  whereby  the  offerer  is 
made  partaker  of  his  God's  table,  in  token 
of  covenant  and  friendship  with  Him,  &c.  . 
more  explicately  thus  :  an  offering  unto  the 
Divine  Majesty,  of  that  which  is  given  for 
the  food  of  man  ;  that  the  offerer,  partaking 
thereof,  might,  as  by  way  of  pledge,  be 
certified  of  his  acceptation  into  covenant, 
and  fellowship  with  his  God,  by  eating  and 
drinking  at  His  table.  St. 'Augustine  comes 
toward  this  notion,  when  he  defines  a  sacri- 
fice (though  in  a  larger  sense)  opus  quod 
Deo  nuncu'pamus,  reddimus,  et  dedicamus, 
hoc  fine,  ut  sancfd  societate  ipsi  adhxreamus  - 
for  to  have  society  and  fellowship  with  God, 
what  is  it  else  but  to  be  in  league  and 
covenant  with  Him  ?  " 

In  a  word,  a  sacrifice  is  ohlatiofoederalis." 
— Joseph  Mede,  Christ.  Sacrif.  c.  2,  p.  356 ; 
Hickes'  Christ.  Priest,  c.  2,  p.  49;  Water- 
land's  Works ;  Johnson's  Unbloody  Sacri- 
fice; Palmer's  Hist,  of  Church,  ii.  463. 

SACEIFICATL  Christians  who,  to 
avoid  condemnation  before  a  heathen  tri- 
bunal, offered  sacrifice  to  an  idol.  When 
such  persons,  after  the  persecution  was  over. 


'670 


SACRILEGE 


returned  to  the  profession  of  Christ,  they 
were  obh'ged  to  undergo  a  very  rigid  penance 
before  they  could  be  re-admitted  into  the 
Chnrch.  It  must  be  observed  that  Sacri- 
ficati  is  their  denomination  as  loenitents, 
■after  their  return  to  the  faith.  Those  who 
continued  in  idolatry  were  simply  apostates 
(See  LibeUatici  and  Tliurificati). — Eusebius, 
H.  E.  lib.  vi.  c.  44;  Cyprian,  Epistolsi; 
Bingham,  xvi.  iv.  5. 

SACEILBGE  (sacrilegium,  from  sacra 
and  lego).  The  act  of  violating  sacred  things, 
or  subjecting  them  to  profanation ;  or  the 
desecration  of  objects  consecrated  to  God. 
Thus  the  robbing  of  churches  or  of  graves, 
the  abuse  of  sacred  vessels  and  altars,  by 
■employing  them  for  unhallovfed  purposes, 
not  consuming  the  consecrated  bread  given 
by  the  priest  (qui  acceptam  a  sacerdote 
Eucharistiam  non  sumpserit),  the  pkmder- 
ing  and  misappropriation  of  alms  and  dona- 
tions, &c.,  are  acts  of  sacrilege  which,  in  the 
ancient  Church,  were  punished  with  great 
severity  (Bingham,  bk.  xvi.,  vi.  23,  seq.). 
The  law  of  sacrilege  now  depends  on  the 
statute  24  &  25  Vict.  c.  96,  which  enacts 
that "  if  any  person  shall  break  and  enter  any 
church,  chapel,  meeting-house,  or  other  place 
of  divine  worship,  and  commit  any  felony 
therein,  or  being  in  church  shall  commit 
any  felony  therein,  shall  be  guilty  of  felony." 
The  punishment  is  penal  servitude  for  life ; 
or  for  not  less  than  three  years,  or  imprison- 
ment for  any  term  not  exceeding  three  years, 
with  or  without  hard  labour. 

SACKING  BELL.  A  bell  which  is  rung 
at  solemn  times  (sacra)  in  the  service.  The 
custom  has  been  attributed  to  Cardinal 
Grey,  when  legate  in  Germany,  c.  a.d. 
1203 ;  it  was  soon  after  that  time  to  be 
found  in  England  ;  and  its  use  was  con- 
firmed by  Gregory  IX.  Becon  {Early 
Works.  Parker  Soc.)  says  that  "  while  the 
■elements  were  blessed,  the  serving-boy  or 
parish  clerk  rang  the  little  sacring  bell." 
Sacring  bell-cotes  remain  in  many  churches, 
and  at  Deddington  the  bell  itself  was  found 
In  the  wall.  Other  instances  are  Hawstead, 
Long  Compton,  Claydon,  Whichford,  and 
Brailes.     [H.] 

SACRISTAN  :  SACRIST.  The  person 
to  whose  charge  the  sacred  vestments,  &c., 
in  a  church,  are  committed ;  now  corrupted 
to  sexton  (See  Sexton).  The  sacristan  is  a 
dignitary  in  some  foreign  cathedrals  (idem 
qui  Thesaurarius),  as  was  formerly  the  case 
at  Glasgow,  and  the  Chapel  Royal  of  Stirling, 
in  Scotland ;  in  both  of  which  places  there 
were  treasurers  also.  At  York  in  1230  the 
■sacristan  was  vice-custos  or  sub-treasurer. 
In  cathedrals  of  the  new  foundation  (see 
'Cathedrals),  the  sacristan  is  a  minor  canon, 
and  has  often  the  special  cure  of  souls  with- 
in the  precincts.    The  sacrist  was  an  inferior 


SAINTS 

officer,  and  as  such  is  mentioned  in  the 
Decretals  of  Gregory  IX.,  and  at  Lyons, 
1269.  Bishop  Storey  in  the  fifteenth 
century  makes  use  of  the  word  sacrist  in  an 
inferior  sense.  In  cathedrals  of  the  old 
foundation  he  was  generally  a  vicar-choral. — 
Durandus,  Rational,  lib.  ii.  c.  1 ;  Walcott's 
Sac.  Arch.  522. 

SACRISTY.  The  place  used  for  robing 
by  the  clergy  and  clerks,  and  in  which 
sacred  vestments,  &c.,  are  kept,  answering  to 
the  modern  vestry.  There  were  generally 
two ;  one  for  the  canons,  the  other  for  the 
vicars-choral,  the  master  of  choir  and  assis- 
tants. See  Diet.  Christ,  Ant.  s.  v.  Dia- 
conicum. 

SAINTS  (Sancti,  Syioi ;  see  Communion 
of  Saints,  Invocation  of  Saints).  A  person 
either  in  the  flesh  or  out  of  it,  who  is  made 
holy  by  the  indwelling  of  the  Holy  Spirit. 
The  people  of  God  have  been  so  designated 
both  in  the  old  and  new  dispensation  (Deut. 
xxxiii. ;  Ps.  1.  5 ;  Rom.  i.  7 ;  Eph.  i.  1, 
&c.).  This  scriptural  use  of  the  word  in  the 
New  Testament  did  not  imply  necessarily 
that  they  were  more  perfect  in  their  lives 
than  other  Christians,  but  that  every  bap- 
tized Christian  as  such  was  a  saint,  holy 
(ayioj),  that  is  to  say,  separated  from  the 
heathen,  unless  he  had  forfeited  his  pri- 
vilege through  sin.  In  like  manner  the 
Israelites  were  called  a  holy  people  mainly 
because  they  were  marked  off  from  other 
nations  by  God,  and  chosen  by  Him  to  be 
recipients  of  a  special  revelation.  Holiness 
of  hving  was  not  asserted  as  a  fact,  although 
it  is  implied  as  the  duty  of  all  who  are  in 
Scripture  called  "saints."  But  the  word 
afterwards  became  more  restricted,  and  was 
applied  to  those  only  who  led  exceptionally 
holy  lives,  or  were  devoted  to  holy  offices. 
Then  it  was  used  especially  to  denote 
martyrs,  from  the  idea  generally  held  at 
that  time  that  their  martyrdom  won  for 
them  immediate  access  to  heaven,  without 
going  through  the  intermediate^state.  In  the 
Creed  we  use  the  word  in  the  widest  sense, 
as  implying  such  persons  as  are  called  by  a 
holy  calling  and  are  not  disobedient  to  it ; 
such  as  are  endued  with  a  holy  faith,  and 
purified  thereby ;  such  as  are  sanctified  by 
the  Holy  Spirit  of  God,  and  by  virtue  thereof 
do  lead  a  holy  life,  perfecting  holiness  in  the 
fear  of  God  (2  Cor.  vii.  1).  Such  persons 
are  really  and  truly  saints;  and  havin<' 
been  holy  in  their  lives  they  do  not  lose 
their  sanctity,  but  improve  it  at  their 
deaths ;  nor  can  they  lose  the  honour  of 
that  appellation,  while  that  which  gives  It 
acquires  perfection.  Hence  grows  that 
necessary  distinction  of  the  saints  on  earth 
and  the  saints  in  heaven ;  the  first  belonging 
to  the  militant,  the  second  to  the  triumphant 
Church.      Of  the  first  David  speaks   ex- 


SAINTS'  DAYS 

pressly :  "  Thou  art  my  Lord ;  iny  goodness 
extendeth  not  to  Thee,  but  to  the  saints 
that  are  in  the  earth "  (Ps.  xvi.  2,  3).  Of 
these  we  read  in  the  Acts  of  the  Apostles ; 
to  these  St.  Paul  directed  his  Epistles.  Of 
the  second  the  Apostle  makes  that  question : 
"Do  ye  not  know  that  the  saints  shall 
judge  the  world?"  (1  Cor.  vi.  2).  And  all 
those  that  are  spoken  of  as  saints  then  in 
earth,  if  truly  such,  and  departed  so,  are 
now,  and  shall  continue  for  ever,  saints  in 
heaven. — Pearson  on  the  Creed,  Art.  ix. 
354;  Bp.  Lightfoot  on  Philippians,  i.  1, 
s.v.  "  5.yioi " ;  Blunt's  Diet  Doct.  Tlieol. 
672.     [H.] 

SAINTS'  DATS  (See  Feasts).  Two 
of  the  most  ancient  monuments  of  eccle- 
siastical history  that  we  possess,  except  the 
New  Testament,  are  the  accounts  of  the 
martyrdom  of  Ignatius  and  Polycarp,  both 
disciples  of  St.  John,  written,  at  the  time 
of  their  suffering  (a.d.  115-117),  by  the 
Churches  of  Antioch  and  Smyrna,  of  which 
they  were  bishops :  and  in  those  mention 
is  made  of  the  intention  of  celebrating 
yearly  the  festival  of  their  birthdays,  of 
their  entrance  into  a  better  life,  for  the 
commemoration  of  their  excellent  graces, 
and  the  incitement  of  others  to  imitate 
them  (Euseb.  iv.  15).  The  anniversary  of 
a  martyr's  death  was  called  his  "natalitia," 
■or  birthday,  and  was  generally  marked  by 
the  faithful  meeting  at  the  place  of  burial, 
recounting  the  acts  of  the  martyr,  and 
■celebrating  the  Holy  Communion  (Tertul. 
de  Coron.  3 ;  St.  Greg.  Nyss.  Vif.  St.  Greg. 
Thaumat.  Op.  ii.  1007;  Cypr.  Ep.  xxxiv., 
xxxvii.,  &c.).  Thus  did  they  provide  that  the 
"  righteous  should  be  in  everlasting  remem- 
brance "  (Ps.  cxii.  6),  and  observed  the  more 
particular  direction  given  to  that  intent  in 
the  Epistle  to  the  Hebrews,  "Remember 
them  which  have  (had)  the  rule  over  you, 
who  have  spoken  unto  you  the  word  of 
<3-od;  whose  faith  follow,  considering  the 
end,"  the  event,  "  of  their  conversation " 
(Heb.  xiii.  7).  Each  of  the  primitive 
■Churches  honoured  the  more  eminent  of 
their  own  martyri!,  who  had  been  usually 
their  teachers  also,  by  anniversary  assemblies 
for  preserving  the  reverence  due  to  their 
characters,  and  offering  up  thanks  to  God 
for  their  examples. 

But  the  increase  of  their  numbers,  and 
the  adoption  of  the  sufferers  of  one  Church 
nto  the  liturgies  of  another,  and  the  ad- 
mission of  eminently  good  persons,  who 
had  "not  resisted  unto  blood"  (Heb.  xii. 
4),  and  the  frequent  grants  which  in  sub- 
sequent ages  were  made,  of  so  high  a  dis- 
tinction, with  little  care  of  previous  inquiry, 
multiplied  the  returns  of  these  solemnities 
very  improperly  and  inconveniently.  Then, 
besides,  a  still  greater  evil  was,  that  praises 


SALUTATION 


C71 


and  panegyrics  too  soon  grew  to  be  immode- 
rate, and  afterwards  impious.  In  the  vehe- 
mence of  national  encomiums  and  exclama- 
tions, the  saint  was  called  upon  as  present, 
until  at  length  he  was  thought  so;  and 
what  at  first  was  merely  a  bold  and  moving 
figure  of  speech,  became  at  length  in  good 
earnest  a  prayer ;  which  requested  of  a  dead 
man,  who  was  not  able  to  hear  it,  not  only 
that  he  would  intercede  with  God  on  behalf 
of  his  fellow  servants,  but  that  he  would 
himself  bestow  such  blessings  upon  them, 
as  no  creature  has  in  his  power.  Things 
being  found  in  this  condition  at  the  Re- 
formation, it  was  necessary  both  to  abolish 
these  prayers  to  the  saints,  who  were  adored 
already  equally  with  the  Deity,  and  to 
limit  the  original  sort  of  commemorations 
to  a  moderate  list  of  holy  persons.  Accord- 
ingly no  day  is  appointed  by  our  Church  for 
the  celebration  of  any  other  than  the  princi- 
pal saints  mentioned  in  the  New  Testament, 
on  which  days  there  are  special  Collects, 
Epistles,  and  Gospels,  implying  the  celebra- 
tion of  the  Eucharist  in  accordance  with  the 
ancient  custom.  There  are  none  such  for 
the  minor  saints'  days,  or  black-letter  days 
(See  Black-Letter  Days). 

When  a  Sunday  and  a  Saint's  day  coin- 
cide, the  general  custom  is  that  the  Saint's 
day  gives  way  to  the  Sunday.  The  men- 
tion of  a  Saint's  day,  however,  falling  on  a 
Sunday  should  be  made  a  memory  by  the 
addition  of  the  Collect  of  the  Saint's  day, 
and  perhaps  by  taking  the  Collect,  Epistle, 
and  Gospel  of  the  Saint's  day,  unless  the 
Sunday  be  one  of  greater  note,  i.e.  either 
the  first  or  fourth  in  Advent,  the  first  or 
last  in  Lent,  Easter-day,  or  the  first  Sundaj' 
after  Whit-Sunday,  Trinity,  or  the  Sundaj' 
next  before  Advent.  In  the  concurrence  of 
a  moveable,  and  immoveable  Saint's  day  on 
a  week-day,  the  following  must  have  pre- 
cedence : — Ash- Wednesday,  the  whole  of 
Passion  Week,  Monday  and  Tuesday  in  the 
weeks  of  Easter,  and  Whitsuntide,  and 
Ascension  Day.' — Robertson,  Eow  to  Con- 
form, p.  50 ;  Proctor,  p.  220 ;  Blunt's 
Parish  Priest,  p.  318  (See  Lessons). 

S  ALUT ATION,  THE.  A  form  of  greet- 
ing to  the  people  in  the  name  of  God,  by 
the  minister.  As  the  people  respond,  it  is 
also  called  the  "  mutual  salutation."  The 
Greek  form  of  salutation  was  "etp^w; 
ircuTi.  Koi  fiera  TrvfVfiaTos  crow."  It  was  used 
on  five  different  occasions  in  Divine  service : 

(1)  by  the  bishop  on  entering  the  church; 

(2)  by  the  reader  before  beginning  the 
lessons ;  (3)  before  and  after  the  sermon ; 
(4)  at  the  consecration  in  the  Holy  Eu- 
charist; (5)  at  the  dismissal  of  the  con- 
gregation. 

In  our  service,  after  reciting  the  Creed 
with  the  people,  the  minister  salutes  the 


672 


SALUTATION 


people  with  "The  Lord  be  with  you" 
(Ruth  ii.  4;  Ps.  cxxii.  8;  2  Thess.  iii.  16), 
and  they  return  it  with  a  like  prayer, 
"And  with  thy  spirit"  (2  Tim.  iv.  22), 
which  words  have  been  of  early  use  in  the 
Christian  liturgies  (Cone.  Vas.  can.  v. 
A.D.  440),  and  is  believed  in  the  Eastern 
Church  to  have  been  handed  down  from  the 
apostles ;  indeed  the  phrase  is  in  the  very 
words  of  St.  Paul ;  and  St.  John  forbids  us  to 
say  to  any  heretic  "  God  speed  "  (2  St.  John, 
ver.  10, 11).  The  oflice  of  the  "  salutation  " 
is  to  make  a  transition,  in  connexion  with 
the  lesser  Litany,  from  tbe  service  of  praise 
to  that  of  supplication.  And  also  to  the 
minister  and  people  having  confe.ssed  them- 
selves "  brethren  in  tlie  faith  "  by  reciting 
the  Creed,  and  being  about  to  ])ray  for  one 
another,  a  note  of  difference  is  here  struck. 
The  people  are  going  to  pray,  which  they 
cannot  do  without  God's  help,  and  therefore 
the  minister  prays  that  "  the  Lord  may  be 
with  them,"  to  assist  them  in  the  duty, 
according  to  that  gracious  promise  oC  our 
Saviour,  that  when  two  or  three  are  met  to 
pray.  He  will  be  with  them  (St.  Matt,  xviii. 
20).  And  since  the  minister  prays  for  all 
tlie  people,  and  is  their  mouth  to  God,  they 
desire  he  may,  heartily  and  devoutly,  offer 
up  these  prayers  in  their  behalf,  saying, 
"  The  Lord  be  with  thy  spirit."  The  same 
salutation  is  used  in  the  confirmation  sei-vice 
after  the  act  of  confirmation,  and  before  the 
Lord's  prayer ;  but  here  the  lesser  Litany  is 
not  connected  with  it.  It  marks,  however, 
the  distinction  between  the  two  parts  of  the 
service.  In  the  ord«r  for  the  visitation  of 
the  sick,  the  priest  is  ordered  to  use  the 
salutation  enjoined  by  our  Lord  or  His 
apostles,  "  Peace  be  to  this  house "  (St. 
Luke  x.  5). 

In  the  Boman  Church  the  angelical 
salutation,  as  it  is  called,  consists  of  the 
angel's  salutation,  and  that  of  Elizaljeth. 
It  runs  thus:  Ave  Maria,  gratise  plena: 
Dominun  tecum:  henedicta  tu  in  mulieribus, 
et  henedictus  fructus  ventris  tui.  Sancta 
Maria,  mater  Dei,  ora  pro  nobis  peccatori- 
hus,  nunc  et  in  hord  mortis  nostra;.     Amen. 

The  latter  clause,  Sancta  Maria,  mater 
Dei,  ora  pro  nobis  peccatorihus,  was  added, 
it  is  said,  in  the  fifth  century ;  but  the  last 
words,  nunc  et  in  hmd  mortis  nostrss,  were 
inserted  by  order  of  Pope  Pius  V. 

Urban  II.  ordered  a  bell  to  be  tolled  three 
times  a  day  to  put  the  people  in  mind  of 
repeating  this  salutation^  that  God  might 
prosper  the  Christian  arms  in  the  recovery 
of  the  Holy  Land;  which  custom,  having 
continued  about  134  years,  fell  at  length 
into  neglect;  till  Gregory  IX.  revived  it, 
with  the  addition  of  a  constant  noon-bell. 

The  repeating  of  this  salutation  at  the 
beginning  of  the  sermon  was  first  enjoined 


SAMUEL 

by  St.  Dominic,  or,  as  some  suppose,  by 
Vincent  Perrerius  (See  Idolatry  and  Mari- 
olatry). 

SALVATION  (See  Covenant  of  Redemp- 
tion).  The  word  is  used  ill  Scripture;  1.  For 
deliverance  or  victory  over  outward  dangers 
and  enemies  (Exod.  xiv.  13 ;  1  Sam.  xiv.  45). 
2.  For  n-mission  of  sins,  true  faith,  repen- 
tance, and  obedience,  and  other  saving  graces 
of  the  Spirit,  which  are  the  way  to  salvation 
(St.  Luke  xix.  9).  "  This  day  is  salvation 
come  to  this  house."  3.  For  eternal  happi- 
ness hereafter,  which  is  the  object  of  our 
hopes  and  desires.  Thus  it  is  said  "  to  give 
knowledge  of  salvation  to  his  people" 
(St.  Luke  i.  77).  "  Godly  sorrow  worketh 
repentance  unto  salvation  "  (2  Cor.  vii.  10). 
And  the  gospel  is  called  the  "gospel  of 
salvation"  (Kph.  i.  13),  because  it  brings 
the  good  news  that  salvation  is  to  be  had  ; 
it  offers  salvation  to  lost  sinners  ;  it  shows 
upon  what  terms  it  may  be  had,  and  the 
way  how  to  attain  it ;  it  also  fits  for  salva- 
tion, and  at  last  brings  to  it.  4.  For  the 
author  of  salvation  (Ps.  xxvii.  1).  "  The 
Lord  is  my  light  and  my  salvation,"  He  is 
my  counsellor  in  all  my  difficulties,  and  my 
comforter  and  deliverer  in  all  my  distresses. 
5.  For  the  person  who  is  the  Saviour  of 
sinners  (St.  Luke  ii.  30).  "  Mine  eyes  have 
seen  thy  salvation,"  says  Simeon ;  I  have 
seen  Him  whom  thou  hast  sent  into  the 
world,  to  be  the  author  and  procurer  of 
salvation  to  lost  sinners.  6.  For  the  praise 
and  benediction  that  is  given  to  God  (Rev. 
xix.  1).  "  Alleluia,  salvation,  and  glory,  and 
honour,  and  power,  unto  the  Lord  our  God." 
The  Hebrews  but  rarely  made  use  of  concrete 
terms  as  they  are  called ;  but  often  of 
abstracted.  Thus,  instead  of  saying,  God 
saves  men,  and  protects  them,  they  say, 
that  God  is  their  salvation.  Thus  the  word 
of  salvation,  the  joy  of  salvation,  the  rock 
of  salvation,  the  shield  of  salvation,  the  horn 
of  salvation,  &c.,  is  as  much  as  to  say,  The 
word  that  declares  deliverance;  the  joys 
that  attend  the  escaping  a  great  danger ;  a 
rock  where  any  one  takes  refuge,  and  where 
he  may  be  in  safety  from  his  enemy ;  a 
buckler,  that  secures  him  from  the  arm  of 
the  enemy;  a  horn  or  ray  of  light,  of 
happiness  and  salvation,  &c. — Cruden's 
Concordance. 
SALISBURY  USE  (See  Use). 
SAMUEL,  THE  BOOKS  OF.  Two. 
canonical  books  of  the  Old  Testament,  so 
called  because  they  are  usually  ascribed 
to  the  prophet  Samuel. 

These  two  books  are  styled  Reigns  in 
the  Greek  version,  and  in  the  vulgar 
Latin,  Kings;  but  in  the  Hebrew  they 
are  styled  the  Books  of  SamueL  But, 
since  the  first  twenty-four  chapters  con- 
tain   all    that    relates   to  the    history  of 


SANCTE  BELL 

Samuel,  and  that  the  latter  part  of  the 
First  Book,  and  all  the  Second,  include  the 
relation  of  events  that  happened  after  the 
death  of  that  prophet,  it  has  been  supposed 
that  Samuel  was  author  only  of  the  first 
tweoty-four  chapters,  and  that  the  pro- 
phets Gad  and  Nathan  finished  the  work. 
This  is  the  opinion  of  the  Talmudists, 
founded  upon  the  following  text  of  the 
Chronicles  :  "  Now  the  acts  of  David,  first 
and  last,  behold  they  are  written  in  the 
book  of  Samuel  the  seer,  and  in  the  book 
of  Nathan  the  prophet,  and  in  the  book 
of  Gad  the  seer." 

The  Books  of  Samuel  and  the  Books  of 
Kings  are  a  continued  history  of  the 
reigns  of  the  kings  of  Israel  and  Judah ; 
for  which  reasfm,  the  Books  of  Samuel  are 
likewise  styled  the  First  and  Second  Books 
of  Kings;  and  the  two  Books  of  Kings 
are  also  called  the  Third  and  Fourth  Books 
of  Kings.  The  first  book  includes  the  space 
<if  about  101  years,  the  second  contains  the 
history  of  about  forty  years,  being  a  full 
account  of  the  transactions  of  King  David 
(See  Speaker's  Commentary). 

SANCTE  BELL.  A  small  bell  which 
was  rung  when  the  "  Sanctus,  Sanctus, 
Sanctas  Dominus,  Deus  Sahaoth  "  was  said, 
to  prepare  the  people  for  the  elevation  of 
the  Host,  at  which  the  sacring  bell  was  rung 
i(See  Sacring  Bell). 

Mr.  Todd,  in  his  additions  to  Johnson's 
Dictionary,  quotes  from  Warton's  History 
of  Kiddington,  as  follows  :  "  It  was  usu- 
ally placed  where  it  might  be  heard  far- 
thest, in  a  lantern  at  the  springing  of  the 
steeple,  or  in  a  turret  at  the  angle  of  the 
tower ;  and  sometimes,  for  the  conveni- 
ence of  its  being  more  readily  and  exactly 
rung,  mthin  a  pediment,  or  arcade,  between 
the  church  and  the  chancel ;  the  rope,  in  this 
situation,  falling  down  into  the  choir,  not  far 
from  the  altar."  So  also  we  read  in  AValton's 
Life  of  George  Herbert ;  "  And  some  of  the 
meaner  sort  of  his  parish  did  so  love  and 
reverence  Mr.  Herbert,  that  they  would 
let  their  plough  rest  when  Mr.  Herbert's 
Saints'  bell  rung  to  prayers,  that  they 
might  also  offer  their  devotions  to  God 
with  him;  and  would  then  return  back  to 
their  plough."  The  small  bell  at  Canter- 
bury rung  before  service,  is  hung  high 
in  the  central  tower,  and  seems  to  answer 
to  the  ancient  Saints'  bell.  Mr.  Todd  adds, 
that  "the  little  bell,  which  now  rings  im- 
mediately before  the  service  begins,  is 
corruptly  called,  in  many  places,  Saucehell, 
or  Sauncehell." 

SANCTIFIGATION  (See  Justifica- 
tion). The  progressive  conformity  of  the 
heart  and  life  to  the  will  of  God,  or  our 
inherent  righteousness,  as  distinguished 
from  the  righteousness  of  justification.     To 


SANCTIFIGATION 


G73 


say  that  we  detract  from  the  necessity  of 
inherent  righteousness,  or  what  is  called 
the  righteousness  of  sauctification,  because 
we  exclude  it  from  the  office  of  justifica- 
tion, and  thus  demolish  the  whole  fabric  of 
human  merit,  is  about  as  reasonable  as  to 
say,  that  because  we  receive  food  by  the 
mouth,  and  not  by  the  ear  or  the  ej'e,  the 
eye  and  the  car  are  unnecessary  members 
in  the  human  frame,  and  that  no  other 
bodily  functions  are  requisite  to  the  life  of 
man.  The  man  will  die  if,  by  tetanus,  he 
is  unable  to  open  his  mouth ;  but  he  will 
also  die  if,  having  received  food  into  his 
mouth,  he  is  unable  to  digest  it ;  and  yet 
the  digestion  of  food,  and  its  mastication, 
are  processes  entirely  distinct,  while  the 
food  itself  is  a  gift  from  without.  It  is 
one  thing  to  assert  that  a  Christian  must 
have  inherent  righteousness,  and  another 
to  assert  that  his  inherent  righteousness  is 
the  ground  of  his  acceptance  with  a  right- 
eous God. 

We  may  refer  to  Hooker  for  a  clear 
exposition  of  the  case :  "  Concerning  the 
righteousness  of  sauctification,  we  deny  it 
not  to  be  inherent ;  we  grant  that,  unless 
we  work,  we  have  it  not ;  only  we  dis- 
tinguish it  as  a  thing  different  in  nature 
from  the  righteousness  of  justification : 
we  are  righteous  the  one  way,  by  the  faith 
of  Abraham;  the  other  way,  except  we 
do  the  ivories  of  Abraham,  we  are  not  right- 
eous. Of  the  one,  St.  Paul,  '  To  him 
that  worketh  not,  but  believeth,  faith  is 
counted  for  righteousness.'  Of  the  other, 
St  John,  '  He  is  righteous  which  worketh 
righteousness.'  Of  the  one,  St.  Paul  doth 
prove  by  Abraham's  example,  that  we  have 
it  of  faith  without  works.  Of  the  other, 
St.  James,  by  Abraham's  example,  that  by 
works  we  have  it,  and  not  only  by  faith. 

"St.  Paul  doth  plainly  sever  these  two 
parts  of  Christian  righteousness  one  from 
the  other.  For  in  the  sixth  to  the  Romans 
thus  he  writeth  :  Being  freed  from  sin,  and 
made  servants  to  God,  ye  have  your  fruit  in 
holiness,  and  the  end  everlasting  life. 

" '  Ye  are  made  free  from  sin,  and  made 
servants  unto  God ;  this  is  the  righteous- 
ness of  justification. 

"  '  Ye  have  your  fruit  in  holiness ; '  this 
is  the  righteousness  of  sauctification. 

"By  the  one  we  are  interested  in  the 
right  of  inheriting;  by  the  other  we  are 
brought  to  the  actual  possession  of  eternal 
bliss,  and  so  the  end  of  both  is  everlasting 
life  "  {Sermon  on  Justification,  §  6). 

In  another  passage  of  the  same  discourse 
(§  31)  Hooker  says  :  "  It  is  a  childish  cavil 
wherewith,  in  the  matter  of  justification,  our 
adversaries  do  so  greatly  please  themselves, 
exclaiming,  that  we  tread  all  Christian 
virtues  under  our  feet,  and  require  nothing 

2  X 


674 


SANCTIFICATION 


ia  Christians  but  faith ;  because  we  teach 
that  faith  alone  justifieth  :  whereas,  by  this 
speech,  we  never  meant  to  exclude  either 
hope  or  charity  from  being  always  joined 
as  inseparable  mates  with  faith  in  the  man 
that  is  justified ;  or  works  from  being 
added  as  necessary  duties,  required  at  the 
hands  of  every  justified  man :  but  to  show 
that  faith  is  the  only  hand  which  putteth 
on  Christ  unto  justification ;  and  Christ 
the  only  garment,  which,  being  so  put  on, 
covereth  the  shame  of  our  defiled  natures, 
hideth  the  impeifection  of  our  works,  pre- 
serveth  us  blameless  in  the  sight  of  God, 
before  whom  otherwise  the  weakness  of 
oxir  faith  were  cause  suflBcient  to  make 
us  culpable,  yea,  to  shut  us  from  the  king- 
dom of  heaven,  where  nothing  that  is  not 
absolute  can  enter." 

"It  is  not  in  question,"  says  Bishop 
Andrewes,  "whether  we  have  an  inherent 
righteousness  or  no,  or  whether  God  will 
accept  or  reward  it;  but  whether  that 
must  be  our  righteousness  coram  rege 
justo  judicium  faciente.  Which  is  a  point 
very  material,  and  in  no  wise  to  be  for- 
gotten. For,  without  this,  if  we  compare 
ourselves  with  ourselves,  what  heretofore 
we  have  been,  or  if  we  compare  ourselves 
with  others,  as  did  the  Pharisee,  we  may 
take  a  fancy,  perhaps,  and  have  some  good 
conceit  of  our  inherent  righteousness.  Yea, 
if  we  be  to  deal  in  schools  by  argument  or 
disputation,  we  may,  peradventure,  argue 
for  it,  and  make  some  show  in  the  matter. 
But  let  us  once  be  brought  and  arraignsd 
coram,  rege  justo  sedente  in  soJio,  let  tis 
set  ourselves  there,  we  shall  then  see  that 
all  our  former  conceit  shall  vanish  straight, 
and  righteousness  in  that  sense  (that  is, 
an  inherent  righteousness,)  will  not  abide 
the  trial "  (Sermons,  vol.  v.  p.  116). 

"The  Homilies  of  our  Church,"  as  Dr. 
Waterland,  adopting  their  doctrine,  observes, 
"  describe  and  limit  the  doctrine  thus : 
'  Faith  doth  not  shut  out  repentance,  hope, 
love,  dread,  and  the  fear  of  God,  to  lie  joined 
with  faith  in  every  man  that  is  justified : 
but  it  shutteth  them  out  from  the  office  of 
justifying ; '  that  is  to  say,  from  the  office 
of  accepting  or  receiving  it ;  for  as  to  the 
office  of  justifying  in  the  active  sense,  that 
belongs  to  God  only,  as  the  same  homily 
elsewhere  declares.  The  doctrine  is  there 
further  explained  thus :  '  Because  faith  doth 
directly  send  us  to  Christ  for  remission  of 
our  sins,  and  that  by  faith  given  us  of  God, 
we  embrace  the  promise  of  God's  mercy, 
and  of  the  remission  of  our  sins  (which 
thing  none  other  of  our  virtues  or  works 
properly  doth),  therefore  the  Scripture  useth 
to  say,  that  faith  without  works  doth 
justify  '"  {Waterland's  WorJcs,  vol.  vi.  27). 
It  is  observed  by  Faber  "  that,   in   the  I 


SANCTUAEY 

progress  of  a  Christian  man  from  his  original' 
justification  to  his  final  salvation,  these- 
several  states  or  conditions  of  righteousness 
successively  appertain  to  him. 

"  First  in  order  comes  the  forensic  right- 
eousness of  justification;  a  righteousness 
reputatively  his,  through  faith,  and  on  ac- 
count of  the  perfect  meritoriousness  of  Christ. 
"  Next  in  order  comes  the  inherent  right- 
eousness of  sanotification  ;  a  righteousness 
infused  into  him  by  the  Holy  Spirit  after- 
he  has  been  justified. 

"  And  last  in  order  comes  the  complete- 
righteousness  of  glorification;  a  righteous- 
ness acquired  by  him,  when  this  corruptible 
puts  on  incorruption,  and  this  mortal  puts 
on  immortality. 

"  The  first  righteousness,  being  the  right- 
ousness  of  Christ,  is  perfect,  but  not  in- 
herent. 

"  The  second  righteousness,  being  the 
subsequently  infused  righteousness  of  a 
justified  Christian  man,  is  inherent,  but  not 
perfect. 

"  The  third  righteousness,  being  the  ac-  - 
quired  righteousness  of  a  departed  Christian, 
man  in  his  glorified  state  hereafter,  is  both 
perfect  and  inherent "  (Prim.  Doct.  Just.  c.  1, 
p.  23). 

SANCTIFY    (See    Sanctification:).    To- 
make  holy,  to  treat  as  holy,  or  to  set  apart 
for  holy  services  (Exod.  xix.  10,  22,  23 : 
XXX.  29  ;  Dent.  v.  13  :  Isa.  viii.  13 :  xxix.. 
23  ;  Eph.  V.  26  ;  1  Thess.  v.  23). 
SANCTUS  (See  Tersanctus). 
SANCTUARY.     I.  The  holy  of  holies 
(Lev.  iv.  6) ;  the  temple  at  large  (2  Chron. 
XX.  8) ;  the  one  place  of  national  worship 
for  the  Israelites  (Deut.  xii.  5) ;  also  the 
place  -vvithin  the  "  cancelli  veniatis,"  or  rails 
where  the  holy  table  stands  in  the  Christian 
church.    This  part  was  always  deemed  the 
most  sacred  part  of  the  church.     To  such 
extremes,  in  their  earnest  desire  for  reverence,, 
did  men  go,  that  persons  desirous  of  com- 
mmiicating  were  disallowed  an  entrance  into 
the  sanctuary  or  altar  part  of  the  church, 
but  had  to  wait  outside  (Gone.  Laodic.  cc. 
19,  4-i).     St.  Ambrose  did  not  permit  Theo- 
dosius  the  emperor  himself  to  commimicate 
in  this  part,  but  obliged  him  to  retire  after 
he  had  made  his  oblation  (Theodoret,  lib.  v. 
c.  18  ;  Sozom.  E.  E.  7,  c.  25).     The  custom, 
however,  differed  in  different  churches,  aud- 
it was  usual,  in  most  places,  for  men  and' 
women  to  come  up  to  the  altar  and  com- 
mimicate  there  (Euseb.   lib.  7,   c.   9 :  10,. 
c.   4);  and  the   second  Council  of  Tours, 
A.D.  567,  orders  the  sanctuary  (sanota  sanc- 
torum) to  be  open  both  to  men  and  women 
to  i^ray  and  communicate  in  at  the  time  of 
the  oblation.     The  reverence  paid  to  the 
sanctuary    might    have  become    excessive 
before   the  Eeformation,  but  there  was  no- 


SANDEMANIANS 

excess  afterwards.  In  fact,  a  great  deal  of 
irreverence  crept  in.  The  sanctuary  was 
disregarded  '  altogether.  The  holy  table 
placed  in  the  middle  of  ^  the  church  was 
used  for  other  purposes  than  that  for  which 
it  was  originally  designed.  On  it  the  church- 
wardens settled  their  accounts,  and  trans- 
acted parish  business.  It  was  the  usual 
receptacle  for  hats  and  cloaks,  except  when 
it  was  cleared  in  order  that  the  children 
might  learn  their  writing  lesson  upon  it.  It 
was  even  used  as  a  seat  by  those  who  found 
it  a  convenient  place  for  hearing  the  sermon 
(Heylin's  Cyprianus  Anglic.  Orig.  p.  273). 
Laud  endeavoured  to  remedy  this  by  re- 
placing the  holy  table  in  the  sanctuary  at 
the  east  end,  but  it  was  brought  against 
him  on  his  trial  and  cost  him  his  life  (See 
Hook's  Archbishops,  xi.  245).  The  feelings 
of  Churchmen,  however,  have  prevailed,  and 
at  the  present  day  the  east  end  of  the  church, 
in  which  the  holy  table  is  placed,  is  re- 
garded as  the  sanctuary,  as  in  the  ancient 
times.     [H.] 

II.  By  sanctuary  is  also  meant  the  privi- 
lege of  criminals  who  have  fled  to  certain 
sacred  places,  to  be  exempt  from  arrest  and 
punishment,  except  ecclesiastical  discipline, 
so  long  as  they  remain  therein.  This  cus- 
tom of  sanctuary,  which  is  now  almost 
everywhere  done  away  with,  for  the  abuse 
to  which  it  gave  rise,  was  derived  from  the 
Levitical  law  of  refuge,  by  which,  at  God's 
express  appointment,  six  cities  were  made 
cities  of  refuge  for  the  involuntary  man- 
slayer:  and  the  altar  of  burnt-offerings 
was  also  a  place  of  refuge  for  persons  who 
had  undesignedly  committed  smaller  of- 
fences (Deut.  xix.  11,  12 ;  Joshua  xx). 
In  this  Divine  law  the  object  seems  to  have 
been  to  mark  God's  hatred  of  sin,  by  show- 
ing that  even  accidental  and  unpremeditated 
offences  were  forgiven  only  by  an  especial 
exercise  of  His  mercy.  The  corrupt  custom 
of  sanctuary  in  the  middle  ages  was  ex- 
tended to  the  protection  of  those  who 
knowingly  and  willingly  committed  the 
most  heinous  offences. — Pegge,  On  Asylum, 
in  Archssologia,  vol.  viii.  p.  13  (See  Asy- 
lum). 

SANDEMANIANS,  or  GLASSITES. 
A  dissenting  community,  which  had  its 
origin  in  the  preaching  and  deposition  of 
one  John  Glas,  Presbyterian  minister  of  the 
parish  of  Tealing,  near  Dundee,  in  1730. 
His  pupU,  Robert  Sandeman,  brought  his 
doctrine  into  England,  and  also  into  America, 
and  from  him  the  sect  derives  its  name, 
though  in  Scotland  it  is  stiU  designated  after 
its  first  founder.  The  Sandemanians  are 
not  a  numerous  sect. 

The  prominent  doctrine  of  the  Sande- 
manians, on  which  they  differ  from  most 
other  Churches,  relates  to  the  nature  of 


SATAN 


675 


justifying  faith,  which  Sandeman  main- 
tained to  be  "  no  more  than  a  simple  asseni 
to  the  Divine  testimony,  passively  received 
by  the  understanding." 

Sandemanians,  also,  observe  certain  pe- 
culiar practices,  supposed  by  them  to  have 
been  prevalent  amongst  the  primitive  Chris- 
tians, such  as  weekly  sacraments,  love  feasts, 
mutual  exhortation,  washing  each  other's 
feet,  plurality  of  elders,  the  use  of  the  lot, 
&c.  In  fact,  their  object  is  to  get  as  near 
as  possible  to  the  primitive  customs,  though 
they  disregard  one  of  the  most  important 
and  primitive  of  all— holy  orders.  Pro- 
fessor Earaday,  the  eminent  chemist,  acted 
as  one  of  their  elders  (See  Wilson's  Hist, 
of  the  Dissenting  Churches  in  London ; 
Bitchie's  Religious  Life  in  London). 

SABUM  (See  Use). 

SATAN.  A  Hebrew  word  \\yif,  signify- 
ing an  adversary,  an  enemy,  an  accuser.  It 
is  often  translated  "  adversary  "  in  our  trans- 
lation of  the  Bible,  as  also  in  the  Septuagint 
and  Vulgate.  For  example  (1  Sam.  xxix. 
4),  the  princes  of  the  Philistines  say  to 
Achish,  "Send  back  David,  lest  in  the 
battle  he  be  an  adversary  to  us,  and  turn 
his  arm  against  us."  The  Lord  stirred  up 
"adversaries"  to  Solomon  in  the  persons  of 
Hadad  and  Rezon  (1  Kings  xi.  14,  23,  &c). 
Sometimes  Satan  is  put  for  the  Devil ;  for 
example,  Satan  presented  himself  among 
the  sons  of  God,  and  the  Lord  said  imto 
Satan,  "  Whence  comcst  thou  ?  "  (Job  i. 
6,  7,  &c.).  And  in  Psalm  cix.  6,  it  is  said, 
"  Let  Satan  stand  at  his  right  hand ; "  and 
in  Zech.  iii.  1,  2,  it  is  said,  "  Satan  standing 
at  his  right  hand ;  and  the  Lord  said  unto 
Satan,  'The  Lord  rebuke  thee,  0  Satan.'" 
In  the  books  of  the  New  Testament,  the 
word  Satan  is  taken  both  in  the  sense  of  an 
adversary,  and  also  for  the  Devil ;  for  ex- 
ample, Christ  says  to  Peter  (St.  Matt.  xvi. 
23), "  Get  thee  behind  me,  Satan :  thou  art  an 
offence  unto  me ; "  that  is,  "  Begone,  O  mine 
adversary :  you  that  withstand  what  I  most 
desire,  and  what  I  came  into  the  world 
to  do."  But  most  commonly  Satan  is  taken 
for  the  Devil  (St.  Matt.  xii.  26  ;  St.  Mark 
iii.  23).  "If  Satan  cast  out  Satan,  he  is 
divided  against  himself."  And  in  the  Reve- 
lation (xx.  2),  "  He  laid  hold  on  the  dragon, 
that  old  serpent,  which  is  the  Devil,  and 
Satan,  and  bound  him  a  thousand  years" 
(See  the  article  Devil). 

SATAN,  KINGDOM  OP.  The  power 
of  Satan  over  the  soul  is  represented  as 
exercised  either  directly,  or  by  his  instru- 
ments. His  direct  influence  over  the  soul 
is  that  of  a  powerful  and  evil  nature  on 
those  in  whom  lurks  the  germ  of  the  same 
evil ;  differing  from  the  influence  exercised 
by  a  wicked  man,  in  degree,  rather  than 
in   kind.      Besides   this   direct    influence, 

2x2 


676 


SATISFACTION 


Scripture  also  tells  us  that  Satan  is  also 
the  leader  of  a  host  of  evil  spirits,  who 
share  his  evil  work — the  officers  of  his  king- 
dom. Thus  in  the  Gospel  (St.  Matt.  xii. 
26 ;  St.  Mark  iii.  23 ;  and  St.  Luke  xi.  18) 
our  Blessed  Lord  represents  Satan  to  us  as  a 
monarch,  who  has  other  subordinate  devils 
obedient  to  him.  St.  Paul  says  in  the  Acts 
(xxvi.  18),  that  all  those  who  are  not  in 
the  religion  of  Jesus  Christ  are  under  the 
empire  and  power  of  Satan.  St.  John 
(Rev.  XX.  7)  predicts  that,  after  a  thousand 
years,  Satan  should  be  unbound,  should  come 
forth  from  hell,  and  subdue  the  nations. 

To  be  "  delivered  up  to  Satan  "  is  to  be  ex- 
communicated or  cut  off  from  God's  Church, 
and  so  surrendered  to  the  Devil  for  a  season. 
St.  Paul  delivered  up  to  Satan  Hymenaius  and 
Alexander  (I  Tim.  i.  20),  that  they  might 
leani  not  to  blaspheme.  He  also  surren- 
dered up  to  him  the  incestuous  person  of 
Corinth  (1  Cor.  v.  5),  "  for  the  destruction 
of  the  flesh,  that  the  spirit  may  be  saved 
in  the  day  of  the  Lord  Jesus  "  (See  Diet, 
of  Bible,  s.  v.). 

SATISFACTION  (See  Atonement,  Co- 
venant of  Redemption,  Jesus,  Propitiation). 

I.  Anything  which  being  done  or  suf- 
fered by  an  offending  creature  himself,  or 
by  another  person  for  him,  shall  secure 
the  favour  of  the  Divine  government,  in 
bestowing  upon  the  offender  pardon  and 
happiness,  may  be  properly  called  a  satis- 
faction or  atonement  made  to  God  for  him. 
In  saying  this,  it  is  not  intended  to  assert 
that  it  is  in  the  power  of  any  creature  to 
satisfy  for  his  own  sins,  for  this  is  impos- 
sible ;  but  only  to  show  what  we  mean 
when  we  speak  of  his  doing  it. 

Such  a  sense  of  the  word  "  satisfaction," 
though  not  in  strict  propriety  of  speech 
amounting  to  the  payment  of  a  debt,  is 
agreeable  to  the  use  of  the  word  in  the 
Roman  law ;  where  it  signifies  to  content  a 
person  aggrieved,  and  is  put  for  some  valu- 
able consideration,  substituted  instead  of 
what  is  a  proper  payment,  and  consistent 
with  a  remission  of  that  debt  or  offence  for 
which  such  supposed  satisfaction  is  made : 
which  is  a  circumstance  to  be  carefully  ob- 
served, in  order  to  vindicate  the  doctrine 
we  are  about  to  establish,  and  to  maintain 
the  consistency  between  different  parts  of 
the  Christian  scheme. 

Christ  has  made  satisfaction  for  the  sins 
of  all  those  who  repent  of  their  sins,  and 
return  to  God  in  the  way  of  sincere,  though 
imperfect  obedience. 

1.  Although  Christ  was  innocent,  never- 
theless he  endured  very  grievous  sufferings, 
both  in  body  and  mind  (Isa.  liii.  3;  St. 
Matt.  xxvi.  38);  and  he  did  this  sponta- 
neously (Heb.  X.  7,  9). 

2'.  It  is  expressly  asserted  in  Scripture, 


SATISFACTION 

that  these  sufferings  were  brought  upon 
Christ /o?"  tlie  sake  of  sinful  men,  in  whose 
stead  he  is  also  said  to  have  suffered  (Isa. 
liii.  5,  6,  10;  St.  Matt.  xx.  28;  Pom.  iii. 
25  :  V.  6,  8 ;  2  Cor.  v.  21 ;  Gal.  iii.  13 ; 
Eph.  v.  2 ;   Heb.  vii.  27 :  ix.  26 :  x.  12 ; 

1  St.  Pet.  ii.  24 :  iii.  18). 

3.  The  offers  of  pardon  and  eternal  sal- 
vation are  made  in  Scripture  to  those  that 
repent  and  return  to  God,  for  the  sake  of 
what  Christ  has  done  and  suffered :  in  whom 
they  are  therefore  declared  to  be  accepted  by 
God,  and  to  whom  they  are  hereupon  taught 
to  ascribe  the  glorv  of  their  salvation  (St. 
John  iii.  14-17  ;  Acts  x.  35,  36,  43 :  ii.  38 : 
iii.  18,   19;,  Rom.  iv.   25;  Col.   i.   20-22; 

2  Cor.  V.  18,  20 ;  Eph.  i.  5,  7  ;  Heb.  ii.  3  : 
ix.  14  :  X.  4,  10,  14 ;  Eev.  i.  5,  6  :  v.  9, 10  : 
vii.  13,  14). 

4.  It  is  evident  that,  according  to  the 
gospel  institution,  pardon  and  life  were  to 
be  offered  to  all  to  whom  the  preaching  of 
the  gospel  came,  without  any  exception 
(St.  Mark  xvi.  15,  16 ;  Acts  xiii.  38,  39 ; 
1  St.  John  ii.  1,  2 ;  Isa.  liii.  6  ;  St.  John 
i.  29). 

5..  It  is  plain,  from  the  whole  tenor  of  the 
epistolary  part  of  the  New  Testament,  as 
well  as  from  some  particular  passages  of  it, 
that  there  was  a  remainder  of  imperfection, 
generally  at  least,  to  be  found  even  in  the 
best  Christians  ;  notwithstanding  which  they 
are  encouraged  to  rejoice  in  the  hope  of  sal- 
vation by  Christ  (Phil.  iii.  13 ;  Gal.  v.  17 ; 
St.  James  iii.  2 ;  1  St.  John  i.  8, 10  :  ii.  1, 2). 

6.  Whereas,  so  far  as  we  can  judge,  the 
remission  of  sin,  without  any  satisfaction 
at  all,  might  have  laid  a  foundation  for 
men's  thinking  lightly  of  the  law  of  God, 
it  is  certain  that,  by  the  obedience  and 
sufferings  of  Christ,  a  very  great  honour 
is  done  to  it ;  and  mercy  communicated  to 
us  as  the  purchase  of  His  blood,  comes  in 
so  awful  as  well  as  so  endearing  a  maimer, 
as  may  have  the  best  tendency  to  engage 
those  who  embrace  the  gospel  to  a  life  of 
holy  obedience. 

II.  The  Roman  idea  of  satisfaction  lies  at 
the  bottom  of  much  of  the  heresy  of  that 
Chm-ch.  It  directly  opposes  the  doctrine 
of  justification  by  faith  only,  and  is  closely 
connected  with  the  Roman  notion  of  the 
merits  of  good  works.  The  following  is  the 
eighth  chapter  of  the  Council  of  Trent  upon 
the  subject. 

"  Lastly,  as  concerns  satisfaction,  which 
of  all  the  parts  of  repentance,  as  it  has  been 
at  all  times  recommended  by  our  fathers  to 
the  Christian  people,  so  now,  in  our  time, 
is  chiefly  impugned,  under  the  highest 
pretence  of  piety,  by  those  who  teach  a 
form  of  godliness,  but  have  denied  the 
power  thereof;  the  holy  synod  declares  that 
it  is  altogether  false,  and  contrary  to  the 


SATISFACTION 

word  of  God,  to  say  that  sin  is  never 
remitted  by  the  Lord,  but  the  entire  punish- 
ment is  also  pardoned.  For,  besides  Divine 
tradition,  clear  and  illustrious  examples  are 
found  in  the  holy  books,  by  which  this 
error  is  most  plainly  refuted.  In  truth, 
even  the  principle  of  Divine  justice  seems 
to  demand  that  they  who  have  sinned 
through  ignorance  before  baptism  should  be 
received  by  him  into  grace,  after  a  different 
manner  from  those  who,  having  been  once 
freed  from  the  bondage  of  sin  and  Satan, 
and  having  received  the  gift  of  the  Holy 
Ghost,  have  not  been  afraid  knowingly  to 
violate  the  temple  of  God,  and  to  grieve  the 
Holy  Spirit:  and  it  becometh  the  Divine 
mercy  that  our  sins  should  fiot  be  so  re- 
mitted without  any  satisfaction,  lest  we  take 
occasion  to  think  lightly  of  our  sins,  and  so, 
injuring  and  insulting  the  Holy  Spirit,  we 
fall  into  worse,  treasuring  up  unto  ourselves 
wrath  against  the  day  of  wrath.  For,  be- 
yond all  doubt,  these  punishments  of  satis- 
faction recall  the  penitents  very  much  from 
sin,  and  restrain  them,  as  it  were,  with  a 
bit,  and  make  them  more  cautious  and 
watchful  for  the  future.  They  cure  also 
the  remains  of  sins,  and  by  actions  of  oppo- 
site virtues,  destroy  vicious  habits  acquired 
by  evil  living.  Nor,  in  truth,  was  there 
ever  any  way  considered  in  the  Church 
more  sure  for  the  removal  of  the  impending 
punishment  of. God,  than  that  men,  with 
real  grief  of  mind,  should  accustom  them- 
selves to  these  works  of  repentance.  To 
this  may  be  added,  that  while  we  suffer  by 
making  satisfaction  for  sins,  we  are  made 
like  unto  Christ  Jesus,  who  made  satisfaction 
for  our  sins,  from  whom  all  our  sufficiency 
is  derived ;  and  having  hence,  also,  a  most 
sure  covenant,  that,  if  we  suffer  with  him, 
we  shall  be  also  glorified  together.  Nor,  in 
truth,  is  this  satisfaction  which  we  pay  for 
our  sins  in  such  sort  ours,  that  it  should  not 
be  through  Christ  Jesus  ;  for  we  who  of 
ourselves  can  do  nothing  as  of  oiorselves, 
can  do  all  things  by  the  assistance  of  him 
who  comforteth  us ;  so  that  a  man  hath 
not  whereof  he  can  boast ;  but  all  our 
boasting  is  in  Christ,  in  whom  we  live,  in 
whom  we  merit,  in  whom  we  make  satis- 
faction ;  doing  worthy  fruits  of  repentance, 
which  have  their  virtue  from  him,  by  him 
are  offered  to  the  Father,  and  through  him 
accepted  of  the  Father.  The  priests  of  the 
Lord  therefore  ought,  according  to  the  sug- 
gestions of  the  Spirit  and  their  ovm  prudence, 
to  enjoin  wholesome  and  suitable  satisfaction, 
proportioned  to  the  quality  of  the  crimes, 
and  the  means  of  the  penitents :  lest,  haply, 
they  become  partakers  in  other  men's  sins, 
if  they  connive  at  sin,  and  deal  too  tender- 
ly with  the  penitents,  enjoining  trifling 
works  for  the  most  grievous  crimes.     Let 


SATISFACTION 


677 


them  have  also  before  their  ej'es,  that  the 
satisfaction  which  they  impose  is  not  only 
for  a  defence  of  the  new  life,  and  a  remedy, 
for  infirmity,  but  also  a  revenge  and  punish- 
ment for  past  sins :  for  the  ancient  Fathers 
believe  and  teach  that  the  keys  of  the 
priests  were  given  not  only  for  loosing  but 
also  for  binding.  Nor  did  they  therefore 
think  that  the  sacrament  of  repentance  is 
the  tribunal  of  anger  and  punishments  ;  just 
as  no  Catholic  has  ever  thought  that,  by 
our  satisfactions  of  this  kind,  the  force  of 
the  merit  and  satisfaction  of  our  Lord  Jesus 
Christ  was  either  obscured  or  lessened  in 
any  degree ;  which,  while  our  innovators  are 
unwilling  to  understand,  they  teach  that  a 
new  life  is  the  best  repentance,  that  they 
may  destroy  altogther  the  virtue  and  use 
of  satisfaction." 

"This,"  says  Perceval  in  his  'Eomish 
Schism,'  "is  a  remarkable  chapter.  The 
repeated  expressions  of  reference  to  our 
Blessed  Lord,  '  in  whom  we  live,  in  whom 
we  merit,  in  whom  we  make  satisfaction 
when  we  perform  worthy  fruits  of  repent- 
ance, which  from  them  have  power,  by  him 
are  offered  to  the  Father,  and  through 
him  are  accepted  of  the  Father,'  plainly 
show  how  keenly  alive  the  Tridentine 
Fathers  were  to  the  danger  of  men  con- 
sidering their  own  penances  as  irrespective 
of  our  Lord's  death  and  mediation,  against 
which  error  they  thus  endeavour  to  guard. 
But  the  other  error  of  making  God,  or 
God's  ministers  in  His  behalf,  through 
vengeance  of  past  sins,  and  not  merely  for 
the  correction  of  the  offence,  insist  upon 
penal  satisfactions  from  those  who,  ndth 
true  repentance,  and  with  faith  in  Christ, 
have  forsaken  their  sins,  as  though  the 
vicarial  punishment  inflicted  upon  the  Son 
of  God  were  not  sufficient  to  satisfy  the 
Divine  vengeance,  is  left,  and  must  needs  be 
left,  untouched.  But  how  great  injury  this 
does  to  the  full,  perfect,  and  sufficient 
sacrifice  of  our  Lord,  and  how  great  in- 
jury also  to  the  character  of  our  heavenly 
Father,  there  need  no  arguments  to 
prove.  The  passages  cited  by  the  pub- 
lishers of  the  Tridentine  decrees  (Gen. 
iii. ;  2  Sam.  xii. ;  Num.  xii.  and  xx.),  being 
all  taken  from  the  old  dispensation,  can- 
not be  pressed,  because  the  analogy  of 
God's  dealings  before  and  after  the  siiffer- 
ings  of  our  Lord  will  not  altogether  hold  : 
besides,  they  all  relate  to  cases  of  open  sin, 
in  which,  for  the  edification  of  others,  tem- 
poral punishment  was  inflicted,  from  which 
no  argument  whatever  can  be  adduced  in 
behalf  of  vindictive  penalties  for  secret 
sins,  ■vjfhich  have  been  repented  of,  con- 
fessed, and  forsaken,  with  faith  in  Christ. 
It  would  seem  from  certain  expressions, 
that  they  consider  the  practice  of  the  vir- 


678 


SAVIOUE 


tues  most  opposed  to  the  sins  committed 
among  the  vindictive  penalties  for  sin.  A 
strange  and  most  unhappy  light  in  which 
to  regard  what  the  Scriptures  would  have 
us  consider  our  highest  privileges  and  our 
choicest  happiness.  That  the  practice  of 
the  Church  of  Rome  is  in  accordance  with 
this  is  placed  beyond  all  doubt,  when  it  is 
known  that  the  repeating  a  certain  number 
of  prayers  is  often  enjoined  as  a  penance 
or  punishment  for  sin." 

SAVIOUR  (See  Jesus).  One  who  deli- 
vers from  danger  and  misery ;  as  God  does 
by  his  providential  care  (Psalm  cvi.  21 ; 
Isa.  xlv.  15,  21 :  Ixiii.  8 ;  Jer.  xiv.  8 ;  1 
Tim.  iv.  10) ;  and  as  does  our  Lord  Jesus 
Christ  (St.  Luke  ii.  11 ;  St.  John  iv.  42 ;  Acts 
V.  31 :  xiii.  23 ;  Eph.  v.  23 ;  Phil.  iii.  20).  He 
saves  from  sin  (St.  Matt.  i.  21) ;  from  the 
thraldom  of  Satan  (Heb.  ii.  14 ;  1  St.  John 
iii.  8);  from  the  world  (Gal.  i.  4);  from 
the  sting  of  death  (1  Cor.  xv.  55,  57) ; 
from  the  grave  (I  Cor.  xv.  22,  23 ;  Phil, 
iii.  20,  21);  from  hell  (1  Thess.  i.  10); 
and  brings  to  the  enjoyment  of  eternal 
bliss  in  heaven  (St.  Matt.  xxv.  34 ;  1  St.  Pet. 
i.  3,  4 ;  2  St.  Pet.  i.  11).  Christ  is  able  to 
save  to  the  uttermost  (Heb.  vii.  25) ;  and 
He  is  willing  to  save  all  who  come  to  Him 
(St.  Matt.  xi.  28  ;  St.  John  vi.  37). 

SAVOY  CONFERENCE.  A  confer- 
ence held  at  the  Savoy,  in  London,  in 
1661,  between  the  Catholic  divines  of  the 
Church  of  England  and  the  Presbyterians. 
The  object  was  to  ascertain  what  conces- 
sions with  respect  to  the  liturgy  could  con- 
ciliate the  Presbyterians,  or  Low  Church 
party  of  that  day.  The  representatives  of 
that  body  demanded  the  discontinuance  of 
all  responses  and  similar  divisions  in  the 
Litany ;  an  abolition  of  saints'  days ;  an  in- 
troduction of  extemporaneous  prayer;  a 
change  as  to  several  of  the  Epistles  and 
Gospels,  which,  remaining  in  the  old  ver- 
sion, contained,  as  they  said,  various  errors  ; 
the  lengthening  of  the  collects ;  the  rejection 
of  the  Apocrypha;  a  removal  from  the 
baptismal  office  of  the  word  regenerated,  as 
applied  to  all  baptized  persons ;  and  a  similar 
rejection  of  the  giving  thanks  for  brethren 
taken  by  God  to  Himself,  as  embracing  all 
alike  who  were  interred,  both  these  phrases 
being  held  incompatible  with  the  commi- 
nation.  They  would  have  the  liturgy  be 
more  particular,  and  the  catechism  more 
explicit.  They  consented  to  give  up  the 
Assembly's  Catechism  for  the  Thirty-nine 
Articles  somewhat  altered ;  and  they  wound 
up  their  expectations  with  the  old  re- 
quest, that  the  cross,  ring,  surplice,  and 
kneeling  at  the  Eucharist  should  be  left 
indifferent. 

On  the  contrary,  the  Church  Commis- 
sioners maintained    that    bishops    already 


SAVOY  GONFEEENOE 

performed  ordination  with  the  assistance 
of  presbyters;  that  it  was  exjjedient  to 
retain  a  certain  number  of  holy-days  for 
the  reasonable  recreation  of  the  labouring 
classes;  that  the  surplice  was  a  decent 
emblem  of  that  purity  which  became  the 
ministers  of  God;  that  its  high  antiquity 
was  shown  by  St.  Chrysostom  in  one  of 
his  homilies;  and  that  it  received  a  sanc- 
tion from  several  passages  in  the  Revela- 
tion (ch.  iii.  4,  5).  They  affirmed  that 
Christ  Himself  kept  the  feast  of  dedica- 
tion, a  festival  of  human  appointment ; 
that  the  sign  of  the  cross  had  been  always 
used  "  in  immortali  lavacro ; "  that  kneeling 
was  an  ancient  and  decent  usage,  and  that 
the  high  antiquity  of  liturgies  in  the  Church 
is  indisputable.  To  the  demand  that  the 
answers  of  the  people  should  be  confined 
to  "Amen,"  they  replied,  that  Dissenters 
say  more  in  their  psalms  and  hymns;  if 
then  in  poetry,  why  not  in  prose?  if  in 
the  Psalms  of  Hopkins,  why  not  in  those  of 
David?  and  if  in  a  Psalter,  why  not  in  a 
Litany  ?  That  Scripture  contained  all  which 
is  needful  for  salvation,  they  deemed  no 
more  an  objection  to  the  Apocrypha  than 
to  preaching.  To  read  the  Communion 
Service  at  the  communion  table  was  main- 
tained to  be  an  ancient  custom,  and  "  let 
ancient  customs  be  observed,  imless  reason 
demands  their  abolition,"  was  the  golden 
rule  of  the  Council  of  Nice. 

They  could  see  no  real  advantage  in 
compromise  and  concession.  What  had 
the  former  alternate  preaching  of  regular 
incumbents  and  puritanical  lecturers  ever 
effected  but  the  sowing  of  perpetual  dis- 
sensions in  every  parish,  the  aspersion  of 
the  characters  and  defeating  of  the  use- 
fulness of  regular  pastors,  and  a  distraction 
of  the  people's  minds  with  different  winds 
of  doctrine,  till  they  knew  not  what  to  be- 
lieve? In  truth,  it  was  certain  that  what- 
ever concessions  might  be  made,  so  long  as 
the  love  of  novelty,  the  pride  of  argumen- 
tation, the  passion  for  holding  forth,  and 
the  zeal  for  proselytizing,  continued  to  be 
principles  in  the  human  heart,  no  conces- 
sion would  ever  abolish  sects  in  religion; 
while  the  Church  of  England,  by  departing 
from  her  ancient  practice,  would  only  com- 
promise her  dignity,  and  forfeit  her  title  to 
due  reverence.  Yet,  since  some  fondly 
conceived  that  all  parties,  tired  of  dissen- 
sion and  disturbance,  were  now  eager  to 
coalesce;  and  that  to  concede  the  minor 
points  of  difference  to  the  Presbyterian 
ministers  would  aiford  them  a  plausible 
excuse  for  maintaining  harmony  without 
violating  their  principles;  they  would  not 
object  to  a  revision  of  the  liturgy,  they 
would  even  give  up  the  ceremonies,  if  any 
shadow  of  objection  could  be  brought  for- 


SAVOY  CONFERENCE 

■ward  oa  the  score  of  their  sinfuluess "  or 
impropriety.  Their  antagonists,  however, 
refused  to  accept  this  challenge,  since  ad- 
mitticg  them  to  be  neither  sinful  nor  im- 
proper, tliey  deemed  it  sufficient  to  show 
-that  a  positive  obligation  should  not  be 
imposed  with  respect  to  things  indifferent. 
On  this  question,  which  was  in  fact  the 
point  at  issue,  as  the  parties  could  come 
■to  no  agreenaent,  the  conference,  like  that 
of  Hampton  Court  in  1604,  terminated  in 
mutual  dissatisfaction  (See  Cardwell's  His- 
tory of  the  Conferences). 

"  The  object  aimed  at  by  those  who  would 
have  lowered  the  terms  of  conformity,  was, 
in  itself,   inexpressibly  inviting.     It    was 
their  hope  to  see    the  great  body  of  pro- 
fessing Christians  in    England  united    in 
•one    communion ;    so    to    annihilate    that 
schism,  which,   in  the  judgment  of  both 
parties,  had  been  the  great  blemish  of  the 
English   Church,  from  almost  the  earliest 
stage  of  the   Eeformation.     But,  allowing 
every  m.erit  to  the   intention,   can  we,  at 
this  day,  refuse   the  praise  of  deeper  fore- 
-sight  to  their  opponents ;  who  argued,  that 
if  some  things  were  changed,  in  order  to 
jilease  the  party  then  applying,  successive 
parties  might  arise,  making  fresh  demands 
■and  inventing  as  good  reasons  for  the  se- 
cond and   third  concessions,   as  had  been 
urged  for  the  first  ?  ...  If  such  an  ecclesi- 
.astical  modification  as  was  wished  for  by 
•Judge    Hale  and  his  associates  had  been 
adopted,    general    pacification    could    not, 
even  then,   have  been   attained;   and  the 
-discovery  of  new  grounds  of  dissent  would 
have  made  the  prosi^ect   more  and  more 
hopeless.     In  the  mean  time,  the  English 
■Church   establishment  would   have  parted 
■with  some  of  its  most  distinguishing  cha- 
racteristics;   those  features,    in  particular, 
•which  are  derived  from  the  ancient  Church, 
would  have  been,  in  a  great  measure,  de- 
faced; and  of  course,  the  principle  of  ad- 
hering, on  all  doubtful  points,  to  (the  con- 
currence of  Christian  antiquity,  could  have 
been    insisted    on   no    longer.     Had     the 
Church  of  England  thus  deserted  her  an- 
•cient  ground,   where,   we  cannot  but  ask, 
should  alteration  have   stopped?     A  prac- 
tice once  originated  is    repeated    without 
difficulty.     Can  we,  then,  entertain  a  doubt, 
that  the  successive  endeavours  which  have 
been  used,  at  one  time,  to  new-modify  the 
.forms  of  our  worship ;  at  another,  to  abate 
ihe  strictness  of  our  doctrinal  creed ;  would 
have  been  as  successful  as,  in  our  actual 
•circumstances,  they  have  proved  abortive  ? 
To  nothing,  under  heaven,  can  we  so  rea- 
sonably ascribe  the  defeat  of  all  such   ef- 
forts,  as  to  the  dread  of  disturbing  what 
had  remained  so  long  substantially  unal- 
•tered.     Had  there  been  no  room  for  this  feel- 


SAYINa 


G79 


ing,  other  considerations  might  not  have 
been  available,  against  the  apparent  plausi- 
bility of  what  was  asked,  or  the  persever- 
ing ardour  of  the  applicants.  Had  the 
work  of  demolition  once  begun,  its  pro- 
gress would  have  been  both  certain  and 
illimitable;  each  successive  change  would 
have  been  the  precedent  for  another,  yet 
more  substantial  and  vital." — Alexander 
Knox,  Pref.  to  2nd  Ed.  of  Burnet's  Lives. 
At  this  conference  there  were  twelve  Angli- 
can, and  twelve  Presbyterian  divines.  Of 
the  former  the  most  famous  were  Sheldon, 
bishop  of  London ;  Cosin,  bishop  of  Durham ; 
Sanderson,  bishop  of  Lincoln;  Pearson, 
afterwards  bishop  of  Chester;  Sparrow, 
afterwards  bishopj  of  Norwich ;  and  Dr. 
Thorndike.  On  the  other  side  were  Baxter, 
Reynolds,  Lightfoot,  Calamy,  and  Bates. 

SAXON.  The  earliest  development  of 
Romanesque,  as  applied  to  ecclesiastical 
architecture  in  England,  is  so  called.  His- 
torically this  style  ought  to  extend  from 
the  coming  of  St.  Augustine  to  the  Con- 
quest (1066) ;  but  the  intercourse  of  England 
with  Normandy  was  so  constant  before  that 
time,  that  there  can  be  no  doubt  we  had 
already  much  Norman  architecture.  It  is 
scarcely  less  to  be  doubted  that  many  more 
ante-Conquest  buUdings  yet  remain  than 
are  usually  accounted  Saxon.  The  characters 
most  relied  on  to  determine  Saxon  work  are 
the  long  and  short  work,  triangular  headed 
doors  and  windows,  the  splaying  of  the 
windows  externally  as  well  as  internally, 
and  the  occurrence  of  baluster  shafts  in  the 
windows.  These,  however,  are  not  constant 
m  well-authenticated  Saxon  bmldings,  nor 
do  they  invariably  indicate  a  Saxon  date. 

SAYING  AND  SINGING.  The  parts 
of  the  service  directed  to  be  said  or  sung,  or 
sung  or  said,  are,  the  Venite,  the  Psalms 
(in  the  title-page  of  the  Prayer  Book),  the 
Te  Deum  (and  by  inference  and  analogy), 
the  Canticles ;  the  Apostles'  Creed,  the 
Litany,  the  Athanasian  Creed,  the  Easter 
Anthem,  the  Nicene  Creed,  the  Sanctus,  the 
Gloria  in  Excelsis,  the  psalm  in  the  Matri- 
monial Service,  the  introductory  sentences 
and  two  anthems  in  the  Burial  Service,  the 
Communion  Service,  the  Communion  Service 
in  the  Ordination  of  Deacons  and  Priests, 
and  the  Veni  Creator  in  the  Ordination  of 
Priests  and  Bishops.  These  two  phrases 
have  no  difference  in  meaning,  since  the 
Apostles'  Creed  is  directed  to  be  sung  or 
said,  in  the  Morning  Service ;  to  be  said  or 
sung,  in  the  Evening.  It  appears  that  the 
ecclesiastical  use  of  the  word  say  is  two- 
fold :  (1)  As  a  general  term,  including  all 
methods  of  recitation,  with  or  without  note, 
or  musical  inflection.  In  this  sense  it  is 
used  in  our  Prayer  Book,  when  employed 
alone.     (2)    As  a  more    technical  and  re- 


680 


SAYING 


stricted  term,  used  in  contradistinction  to 
singing;  and  yet  not  to  singing  in  the 
general  sense,  but  in  one  or  more  of  its 
restricted  senses. 

For  the  word  sing,  as  is  well  known,  has 
more  than  one  ecclesiastical  sense ;  since  it 
includes,  (1)  all  that  is  recited,  in  whatever 
way,  in  a  musical  tone ;  in  which  sense  it  is 
used  in  the  Prayer  Book ;  (2)  that  which 
is  chanted,  like  the  Psalms,  Athanasian 
Creed,  and  Litany ;  (3)  that  which  is  sung 
anthemwise,  like  the  Anthems,  Canticles, 
Hymns,  and  Nicene  Creed.  In  these  two 
last  senses  it  is  contradistinguished  from  say 
in  the  Prayer.Book. 

The  phrase  sung  or  said  is  applied  to  those 
parts  of  the  service  only,  in  which,  when 
said,  the  minister  has  a  distinctive  part, 
whether  (1)  leading  or  preceding  the  peo- 
i:le  in  each  clause ;  or  (2)  reciting  alternate 
verses  \vith  them  ;  or  (3)  reciting  the  pas- 
sage alone;  hut  which,  when  sung,  are 
^ung  by  the  minister  and  people,  or  choir, 
all  together,  without  any  distinctive  part 
being  assigned  to  him.  And  it  may  be 
added,  these  parts  may  be,  and  usually 
are,  sung  to  the  organ.  The  phrase  never 
apphes  to  those  parts  of  the  service  which 
are  always  to  be  repeated  by  the  minister 
alone  in  the  versicle,  and  by  the  people  in 
the  response. 

The  instance  given  above  of  the  Com- 
munion Service  in  the  Ordination  of  Priests 
and  Bishops,  is  the  only  direction  to  which 
this  rule  does  not  appear  exactly  applicable. 
But  here,  from  the  nature  of  the  case,  the 
Communion  Service  is  spoken  of  in  a 
general  way;  and  we  are,  of  course,  re- 
feiTed  to  its  special  rubrics  in  their  proper 
places.  All  that  is  meant  is  this,  that  the 
service  shall  he  perfonned  chorally  or  not 
chorally,  according  as  circumstances  may 
allow  or  require. 

The  Apostles'  Creed  is  the  only  instance 
in  which  the  permission  or  injunction  of 
the  rubric  to  siog  this  part  of  the  service 
(that  is,  to  sing  it  anthemwise,  or  to  the 
organ),  has  never  been  acted  on.  This 
rubric  was  altered  to  its  present  form  at  the 
last  review ;  as  before  it  had  merely  been 
directed  to  be  said.  The  words  "  or  sung  " 
seem  to  have  been  inserted  in  order  to  pre- 
serve the  analogy  between  this  creed  and 
the  Nicene,  which  it  resembles  in  its  con- 
struction. 

With  regard  to  the  Litany,  when  said, 
it  is  repeated  alternately,  as  verse  and 
response,  by  the  minister  and  people. 
But  the  choral  usage  is,  in  some  cathe- 
drals, not  that  the  minister,  or  a  priest,  but 
Uvo  chanters  should  sing  together  those 
parts  which  the  minister  reads  in  a  parish 
church,  and  which  in  some  old  choral  books 
are  here  called  versides,  as  far  as  the  Lord's 


SCAEF 

Prayer  exclusive.  And  this,  not  with  the 
common  intonation  and  inflection  used  in 
prayers  and  versicles  (which  have  come 
under  the  denomination  of  singing),  but 
with  the  modulation  of  a  regular  chant ; 
which  in  some  parts  of  the  Litauy  (the  in- 
vocation e.g.)  these  two  chanters  sing 
throughout ;  while  in  others  they  form  the 
first  part  of  the  chant,  the  response  of  the 
choir  forming  the  second.  This  particular 
service  has  often  been  set  to  artificial  music, 
both  before  and  after  the  last  review.  No 
notice  of  Minister  (or  Priest)  and  Answer 
are  prefixed  to  the  former  part  of  the 
Litany ;  while  in  the  latter  part,  when 
there  are  such  notices,  the  suffrages  are 
always  recited  by  one  minister,  and  answered 
by  the  choir  or  people  (See  Litany), 

Now  if  in  a  choir  the  minister  were  to 
read,  or  simply  intone,  the  versicles  of  the 
first  part  of  the  Litany,  that  service  would 
then  not  he  sung,  but  said,  according  to  the 
meaning  of  the  rubric,  even  though  the 
responses  were  chanted ;  the  word  singing 
including  the  luhole  portion  of  the  service 
then  specified,  not  a  part  only.  And  this 
is  probably  the  reason  why  the  ancient 
harmonized  Litanies  by  various  composers 
are  generally  set  to  music  in  the  former  part 
only ;  the  supplications,  or  latter  part,  being 
customarily  sung  in  choirs  to  the  ordinary 
chant. 

But  the  rubrics  by  no  means  interfere 
with,  and  indeed  do  not  allude  to,  the 
chanting  of  prayers  and  responses  imme- 
moriaUy  used  in  choirs  ;  the  singing  which 
the  rubrics  specify  being  a  different  thing 
from  choral  or  responsional  recitation.  The 
responses  were,  and  are  still,  frequently 
sung  to  the  organ.  But  singing  (as  used  in 
the  Prayer  Book)  never  has  reference  to  a 
mere  response.  In  fact,  the  word  answer  is 
an  ecclesiastical  term,  which  in  choirs  always 
implies  singing  (in  its  common  and  general 
sense),  as  reference  to  the  older  documents 
on  which  otir  Prayer  Book  was  based  will 
show.     [H.]  , 

SCAEF  (See  Stole).  Apiece  of  silk  or 
other  stuff  which  hangs  from  the  neck,  and 
is  worn  over  the  rochet  or  surplice.  It  is 
not  mentioned  in  the  rubric  of  the  English 
ritual,  but  is  worn  by  our  bishops  and  dig- 
nitaries of  the  Church,  and  by  D.D.'s  in  the 
University  (see  Canon  74).  It  is  used  from 
long  custom,  and  may  be  referred  to  the 
ancient  practice  of  the  Church,  according  to 
which  presbyters  and  bishops  wore  a  scarf 
or  stole  in  the  administration  of  the  sacra- 
ments, and  on  some  other  occasions.  The 
stole  has  been  used  from  the  most  primitive 
ages  by  the  Christian  clergy.  It  was 
fastened  on  one  shoulder  of  the  deacon's  alb, 
and  hung  down  before  and  behind.  The 
priest  had  it  over  both  shoulders,  and  the 


SCEPTICS 

ends  of  it  liung  down  in  front.  Thus  simi^ly 
were  the  dresses  of  the  priests  and  deacons 
distinguished  from  each  other  in  primitive 
tioies.  For  some  years  scarfs  were  supposed 
to  belong  to  bishops'  and  peers'  chaplains, 
but  for  no  good  reason.  They  were  wider 
than  the  now  common  stole,  and  may  pro- 
bably be  identified  with  the  "  black  tii^pet " 
of  the  canons  (See  Tippet). 

SCEPTICS  (Prom  the  Greek  word 
(TKiirroiiai,  to  look  about,  to  deliberate).  This 
word  was  applied  to  an  ancient  sect  of 
pliilosophers  founded  by  Pyrrho,  who  denied 
tlie  real  existence  of  all  qualities  in  bodies 
except  those  which  are  essential  to  primary 
atoms,  and  referred  everything  else  to  the 
lierceptions  of. the  mind  produced  hy  ex- 
cernal  objects ;  in  other  words,  to  appearance 
and  opinion.  In  modern  times,  the  word  is 
applied  to  Deists,  and  those  who  deny  any 
revelation  (See  Bationalism). 

SCHISM  (Lat.  schisma;  Gk.  <Txi<Ty^,  from 
o-xife'";  to  divide),  in  the  ecclesiastical 
sense  of  the  word,  is  a  breaking  off  from 
communion  with  the  Church,  on  account  of 
some  disagreement  in  matters  of  faith  or 
discipline. 

We  shall  easily  leani  what  the  ancients 
meant  by  the  unity  of  the  Church  and 
schism,  if  we  consider  the  following  par- 
ticulars : — 1.  That  there  were  different  de- 
grees of  unity  and  schism,  according  to  the 
proportion  of  which  a  man  was  said  to  be 
more  or  less  united  to  the  Church,  or  divided 
from  it.  2.  That  they  who  retained  faith 
and  baptism,  and  the  common  form  of 
Christian  worship,  were  in  those  respects  at 
unity  with  the  Church ;  though,  in  other 
respects,  in  which  their  schism  consisted, 
they  might  be  divided  from  her.  3.  That 
to  give  a  man  the  denomination  of  a  true 
Catholic  Christian,  absolutely  speaking,  it 
was  necessary  that  he  should  in  all  respects, 
and  in  every  kind  of  unity,  be  in  perfect 
and  fall  communion  with  the  Church ;  but 
to  denominate  a  man  a  schismatic,  it  was 
suflBcient  to  break  the  unity  of  the  Church 
in  any  one  respect ;  though  the  malignity 
of  the  schism  was  to  be  interpreted,  more  or 
less,  according  to  the  degrees  of  separation 
he  made  from  her.  Because  the  Church 
could  not  ordinarily  judge  of  men's  hearts, 
or  of  the  motives  that  engaged  them  in 
error  and  schism,  therefore  she  was  forced 
to  proceed  by  another  rule,  and  judge  of 
their  unity  with  her  by  their  external  com- 
munion and  professions. 

And  as  the  Church  made  a  distinction 
between  the  degrees  of  schism,  so  did  she 
between  the  censures  inflicted  on  schis- 
matics ;  for  these  were  proportioned  to  the 
quality  and  heinousness  of  the  offence. 
Such  as  absented  themselves  from  church 
-  for  a  short  time  (which  was  reckoned  the 


SCHOOLS 


681 


lowest  degree  of  separation)  wore  punished 
with  a  few  weeks'  suspension.  Others,  who 
attended  only  some  part  of  the  service,  and 
voluntarily  withdrew  when  the  Eucharist 
was  to  be  administered ;  these,  as  greater 
criminals.  Were  denied  the  privilege  of 
making  any  oblations,  and  excluded  for 
some  time  from  all  the  other  holy  ofBces  of 
the  Church.  But  the  third  sort  of  separatists, 
who  are  most  properly  called  schismatics, 
being  those  who  withdrew  totally  and  uni- 
versally from  the  communion  of  the  Church, 
and  endeavoured  to  justify  the  separation ; 
against  these  the  Church  proceeded  more 
severely,  using  the  highest  censure,  that  of 
excommunication,  as  against  the  professed 
enemies  and  destroyers  of  her  peace  and 
unity. 

Ecclesiastical  history  presents  us  with  a 
view  of  several  considerable  schisms,  in 
which  whole  bodies  of  men  separated  from 
the  communion  of  the  Catholic  Church. 
Such  were,  in  the  fourth  century,  the  schisms- 
of  the  Donatists,  and  the  many  heretics  that 
sprang  up  in  the  Church,  as  the  Arians, 
Photinians,  ApoUinarians,  &c.,  the  schisni 
of  the  Church  of  Antioch,  occasioned  by 
Lucifer,  bishop  of  Cagliari,  in  Sardinia  ;  in 
the  fifth  century,  the  schism  of  the  Church 
of  Kome,  between  Laurentius  and  Symma- 
chus ;  in  the  ninth  century,  the  separation 
of  the  Greek  Church  from  the  Latin ;  but, 
particularly,  the  grand  schism  of  the  popes 
of  Eome  and  Avignon,  in  the  fourteenth 
century,  which  lasted  till  the  end  of  the 
Council  of  Pisa,  1409. — Bingham,  bk.  xvi. 
c.  1,  17. 

The  deprecation  in  the  Litany  against 
heresy  and  schism  was  added  in  1661  after 
the  many  schisms  by  which  the  Church  was 
rent  during  the  period  of  the  great  Eehellion. 
The  spirit  of  party  within  the  Church  is- 
inchoate  schism.  It  divides  the  interests  of 
a  portion  of  the  Church  from  those  of  tho 
whole  Church,  and  so  tends  to  the  breach  of 
outward  unity.  Schism  may  originate  in 
dissatisfaction  with  the  teaching  or  with  the 
government  of  the  Church.  Its  sin  lies  in 
its  disruption  of  the  one  body  (Eph.  iv. 
4,  5).  Its  special  dangers  lie  in  wilful 
abandonment  of  those  means  of  grace  of 
which  the  Church  is  the  divinely  appointed 
channel,  and  in  the  ever-increasing  liability 
to  falling  away  further  and  further  from 
orthodox  teaching  and  practice.  Heresy 
leads  to  schism,  and  schism,  in  its  turn,  has 
a  tendency  to  encourage  heresy.  Moreover 
experience  teaches  us  that  schism  begets 
schism.  The  child  naturally  manifests  the 
disloyal  and  unfilial  spirit  of  the  parent. — 
E.  Daniel's  P.  B.  p.  172. 

SCHOOLS.  The  word  was  anciently 
of  larger  appHcation  than  at  present,  and 
signified  places  of  instruction  not  only  for 


«82 


SCHOOLS 


childi'en,  but  for  those  of  more  advanced 
age.  It  was  applied  generally  to  what  are 
now  called  universities.  Thus  Shakspeare, 
in  "  Hamlet,"  speaks  of  being  at  school  at 
Wittenberg,  that  is,  at  the  university.  The 
places  in  the  universities  where  exercises 
for  degrees  are  performed,  and  lectures 
a-ead,  are  still  called  schools,  both  in  Eng- 
land, and  at  least  in  the  older  universities 
of  Europe:  and  academical  degrees  were 
often  called  degrees  nf  school. 

By  Canon  77.  "No  man  shall  teach 
either  in  public  school  or  private  house, 
but  such  as  shall  be  allowed  by  the  bishop 
■of  the  diocese,  or  ordinary  of  the  place, 
under  his  hand  and  seal;  being  found 
meet,  as  well  for  his  learning  and  dexterity 
in  teaching,  as  for  sober  and  honest  con- 
ipersation,  and  also  for  right  understanding 
of  Grod's  true  religion ;  and  also  except  he 
first  subscribe  simply  to  the  first  and  third 
articles  in  the  36th  canon,  concerning  the 
ting's  supremacy,  and  the  Thirty-Nine 
Articles  of  Religion,-  and  to  the  two  first 
clauses  of  the  second  article,  concerning 
the  Book  of  Common  Prayer,  viz.  that  it 
containeth  nothing  contrary  to  the  word 
•of  Grod,  and  may  lawfully  be  used." 

By  Canon  78.  "  In  what  parish  church 
or  chapel  soever  there  is  a  curate,  which 
is  a  master  of  arts,  or  bachelor  of  arts,  or 
is  otherwise  well  able  to  teach  youth,  and 
will  willingly  so  do,  for  the  better  increase 
of  his  living,  and  training  up  of  children 
in  principles  of  true  religion,  we  will  and 
ordain  that  a  licence  to  teach  youth  of  the 
parish  where  he  serveth  be  granted  to  none 
by  the  ordinary  of  that  place,  but  only  to 
the  said  curate :  provided  always,  that  this 
•constitution  shall  not  extend  to  any  parish 
or  chapel  in  country  towns,  where  there  is 
a  public  school  founded  already ;  in  which 
case  we  think  it  not  meet  to  allow  any  to 
teach  grammar,  but  only  him  that  is 
allowed  for  the  said  public  school." 

By  Canon  79.  "  AH  schoolmasters  shall 
teach  in  English  or  Latin,  as  the  children 
are  able  to  bear,  the  larger  or  shorter 
catechism,  heretofore  by  public  authority 
set  forth.  And  as  often  as  any  sermon 
shall  be  upon  holy  and  festival  days,  within 
the  parish  where  they  teach,  they  shall 
bring  their  scholars  to  the  church  where 
such  sermons  shall  be  made,  and  there  see 
them  quietly  and  soberly  behave  them- 
selves, and  shall  examine  them  at  times 
convenient  after  their  return,  what  they 
have  borne  away  of  such  sermons.  Upon 
other  days,  and  at  other  times,  they  shall 
train  them  up  with  such  sentences  of  Holy 
Scriptures,  as  shall  be  most  expedient  iio 
induce  them  to  all  godliness.  And  they 
shall  teach  the  grammar  set  forth  by  King 
Henry  Till.,  and  continued  in  the  times  of 


SCHOOLS 

King  Edward  VI.  and  Queen  Elizabeth  of 
noble  memory,  and  none  other.  And  if  any 
schoolmaster,  being  licenced,  and  having 
subscribed  as  is  aforesaid,  shall  offend  in 
any  of  the  premises,  or  either  speak,  write, 
or  teach  against  anything  whereunto  he 
hath  formerly  subscribed,  if  upon  admoni- 
tion by  the  ordinary  he  do  not  amend  and 
reform  himself,  let  him  be  suspended  from 
teaching  school  any  longer." 

"  The  larger  or  shorter  catechism." — The 
shorter  is  that  in  the  Book  of  Common 
Prayer  ;  the  larger  was  a  catechism  set 
forth  by  King  Edward  VI.,  which  he  by 
his  letters  patents  commanded  to  be  taught 
in  all  schools;  which  was  examined,  re- 
viewed, and  corrected  in  the  convocation 
of  1562,  and  published  with  those  improve- 
ments in  1570,  to  be  a  guide  to  the  younger 
clergy  in  the  study  of  divinity,  as  contain- 
ing the  sum  and  substance  of  our  reformed 
religion. — Gibson,  374. 

"  Shall  bring  their  scholars  to  the  church." 
— E.  10  &  11  W.  Betclmm,  and  Barnardis- 
ton.  The  chief  question  was,  whether  a 
schoolmaster  might  be  prosecuted  in  the 
ecclesiastical  court  for  not  bringing  his 
scholars  to  church,  contrary  to  this  canon. 
And  it  was  tbe  opinion  of  the  court  that 
the  schoolmaster,  being  a  layman,  was  not 
bound  by  the  canons. 

"  Grammar." — Compiled  and  set  forth  by 
William  Lily  and  others  specially  ap- 
pointed by  his  Majesty ;  in  the  preface  to 
which  book  it  is  declared  that,  "  as  for  the 
diversity  of  grammars,  it  is  well  and  pro- 
fitably taken  away  by  the  king's  Majesty's 
\visdom  ;  who  foreseeing  the  inconvenience, 
and  favourably  providing  the  remedy, 
caused  one  kind  of  grammar  by  sundry 
learned  men  to  be  diligently  drawn,  and  so 
to  be  set  out  only;  everywhere  to  be 
taught  for  the  use  of  learners,  and  for 
avoiding  the  hurt  in  changing  of  school- 
masters." 

The  first  elementary  Day  Schools  for  the 
children  of  the  poor  in  England  were  founded 
by  the  Society  for  the  Promotion  of  Christian 
Knowledge  in  1698.  A  clergyman  was 
appointed  by  the  Society  to  inspect  these 
schools  in  1700.  Before  twenty  years  had 
passed  Charity  Schools  had  been  established 
in  every  great  centre  of  population  through- 
out the  kingdom. 

Sunday  Schools  originated  in  the  classes 
held  for  the  instruction  of  the  young  by 
St.  Charles  Borroraeo,  and  were  introduced 
into  England  by  Mr.  Eobert  Kaikes  at 
Gloucester  in  1781,  at  the  suggestion  of  the 
Rev.  Thomas  Stock,  Master  of  the  Cathedral 
School. 

The  following  succinct  and  lucid  history 
of  public  education  for  the  poor  in  Eng- 
land during  the  greater  part  of  the  first  half 


SCHOOLS 

of  the  present  century  was  given  by  the 
bishop  of  Gloucester  and  Bristol,  in  his 
visitation  charge  of  1847 : — 

"  The  system  of  mutual  instruction  was 
first  promulgated  in  this  island  by  Pr. 
Andrew  Bell,  exactly  half  a  century  from 
the  present  time;  and  that  invention, 
when  generally  known,  drew  jjeoplc's  minds 
to  the  subject  of  schools  for  the  children  of 
the  poor ;  for  it  was  thought,  that  a  method 
by  which  one  person  could  inspect  the 
instruction  of  great  numbers  would  reduce 
so  materially  the  expense,  as  to  render  it  no 
longer  hopeless  to  procure  some  education 
jfor  all  the  inhabitants  of  the  country.  In 
the  early  years  of  the  nineteenth  century, 
this  became  the  subject  of  earnest  disscusion 
and  controversy :  and  with  good  reason ; 
for  it  seemed  an  obvious  consequence,  that 
■a  machinery  by  which  large  numbers  could 
be  instructed  together,  would  place  in  the 
hands  of  those  who  directed  that  instniction 
A  powerful  moral  engine  to  affect  the  minds 
of  the  rising  generation.  The  sectaries  were 
not  slow  in  availing  themselves  of  that 
engine ;  and  as  the  religious  differences  of 
dissenting  parents  were,  by  some,  considered 
■a  reason  against  their  children  using  the 
catechism  of  the  Church,  it  was  maintained 
by  them,  that  nothing  should  he  taught  in 
those  large  seminaries  except  such  truths 
jis  all  Christians,  of  every  complexion  and 
denomination,  could  agree  to  accept.  Many 
faithful  ministers  of  the  Church  felt  that 
they  would  not  be  justified  before  God  or 
man  in  abdicating  one  of  their  most 
essential  functions,  that  of  watching  the 
instruction  of  their  young  parishioners,  and 
they  recoiled  from  any  proposal  of  com- 
promising Divine  truths  ;  accordingly,  they 
were  found  strenuously  to  resist  that  scheme. 
With  the  view  of  directing  the  education  of 
the  poor  in  the  principles  of  the  National 
Church,  in  the  year  1812  was  established 
the  National  Society,  an  institution  which 
has  ever  since,  by  various  methods,  assisted 
.our  schools — ^by  contributions  towards  their 
erection — by  training  teachers — by  impart- 
ing advice  and  information — and  by  main- 
taining consistency  and  efficiency  in  an 
extensive  and  rather  complicated  system. 
It  was,  I  believe,  about  thirty  years  ago 
that  this  momentous  subject  acquired  in- 
^•jeased  importance  in  the  public  eye,  by  the 
reports  of  an  Education  Committee  of  the 
House  of  Commons  ;  and  it  was  then  first 
suggested,  that  an  object  of  such  vast 
consequence  as  national  education  claimed 
the  direct  assistance  of  the  State,  and  that 
nothing  less  than  aid  from  the  public  purse 
could  ever  compass  the  great  object  of  uni- 
versal instruction.  But  it  was  not  until  the 
year  1833,  that  the  least  assistance  was 
rendered  by  the  government  or  parliament 


SCHOOLS 


683 


towards  that  work.  Schools  had  indeed 
increased  in  number,  and  the  public  mind 
had  become  more  and  more  favourable  to 
the  undertaiving.  But  the  countenance 
then  first  given  to  popular  education  by 
parliament,  seems  to  have  originated  in 
political  considerations.  The  population  of 
the  country  had  increased  with  surprising 
rapidity ;  and  the  vast  numbers  of  poor 
congregated  in  towns,  particularly  in  the 
manufacturing  and  mining  districts,  left  far 
behind  them  all  the  efforts  of  private  bene- 
volence. At  the  same  time,  a  fearful 
increase  was  observed  in  the  amount  of 
crime ;  and  an  examination  of  the  unhappy 
inmates  of  prisons  proved  that  a  great 
majority  were  destitute  of  every  kind  of 
instruction :  on  the  other  hand,  of  the  edu- 
cated part  of  the  poorer  classes,  very  few 
were  discovered  in  the  criminal  ranks. 
Such  considerations  showed  the  extreme 
danger  of  suffering  masses  of  the  people  to 
grow  up  in  ignorance  of  moral  and  religious 
duties,  and  weighed  with  parliament  to 
make  a  grant  towards  buildiug  school-rooms. 
The  amount  was  indeed  trifling  compared 
with  the  demand,  being  only  £20,000  for 
England  and  Wales  :  but  the  like  sum  was 
rei^eated  for  five  successive  years ;  and, 
niggardly  as  these  grants  have  been  generally 
called,  it  woidd  be  ungi-ateful  not  to  acknow- 
ledge that  they  did  cause  a  great  extent  of 
good  throughout  the  country.  The  money 
granted  by  the  Treasury  being  proportioned 
to  the  sums  advanced  by  private  subscrip- 
tions, was  effectual  in  stimulating  a  large 
amount  of  individual  charity,  and  thus 
called  into  being  a  multitude  of  schools 
that  could  not  otherwise  have  had  exist- 
ence. The  Treasury'  grants  being  conveyed 
through  the  National  Society  to  Church 
schools,  and  through  the  British  and  Foreign 
Society  to  Dissenting  schools,  to  meet  the 
sums  respectively  subscribed,  the  result  was, 
that  no  less  than  five-sixths  of  the  whole 
were  allotted  to  the  former  ;  thereby  givmg 
a  signal  proof  of  the  greater  zeal  in  the 
cause  of  education  which  animated  Church- 
men. 

"  However,  the  experience  of  so  many 
years  too  jilainly  showed  that  the  education, 
if  such  it  could  be  called,  which  was  given 
to  the  poor,  was  inadequate  and  unsatis- 
factory. The  system  of  mutual  instruction, 
though  to  a  certain  extent  useful  when 
judiciously  directed,  was  found  not  to  be 
capable  of  those  wonderful  effects  upon 
which  sanguine  minds  had  calculated. 
Besides,  the  early  age  at  which  children 
were  generally  deprived  of  school  instmotion, 
through  the  necessities  or  the  cupidity  of 
their  parents,  perpetually  disappointed  the 
hopes  of  their  intellectual  proficiency.  But, 
above  all,  the  inadequate  qualification  of  the 


684 


SCHOOLS 


masters  and  mistresses  of  National  Schools 
precluded  all  prospect  of  such  an  education 
as  might  elevate  the  mind.  The  srnallness 
of  their  salaries,  mainly  depending  upon 
precarious  subscriptions,  almost  excluded 
persons  of  ahility  and  energy  from  situations 
in  which  those  qualities  are  peculiary  re- 
quired. Frequently  the  instructors  of  the 
rising  generation  were  persons  who  had  been 
unsuccessful  in  their  endeavours  to  obtain  a 
livelihood  in  other  lines  of  life,  who  had 
never  turned  their  attention  to  the  subject 
of  education,  and  were  destitute  of  the 
temper,  discernment,  and  love  of  the  pro- 
fession, which  should  be  combined  in  a 
good  teacher ;  and  a  few  weeks'  attendance 
in  the  central  school  (when  funds  could  be 
found  for  that  purpose")  was  seldom  sufficient 
to  remedy  previous  inaptitude,  or  to  confer 
appropriate  habits  and  address.  Against 
these  difficulties,  the  clergy,  feeling  that 
upon  them  the  responsibility  was  cast,  long 
struggled  with  exemplary  zeal  and  patience ; 
a  state  of  things  which  still  continues. 
Many  are  the  cases  where  the  whole  pecuniary 
support  of  a  school,  beyond  the  weekly 
pence  of  tlie  children,  rests  with  the 
minister ;  and  whatever  is  of  any  value  in 
the  teaching,  proceeds  from  himself,  or  the 
members  of  his  familj'. 

"From  observation  of  these  and  other 
defects  in  our  system,  and  from  a  deep 
sense  of  the  duty  of  a  Christian  nation  to 
bring  up  its  people  in  Christian  principles, 
the  National  Society  promulgated  a  new 
and  comprehensive  plan,  the  object  of  which 
was  to  establish,  in  every  diocese,  training 
schools  for  teachers,  to  combine  them  with 
seminaries  for  the  children  of  the  middle 
classes  (who  had  before  been  unaccountably 
overlooked  in  our  schemes  of  national  edu- 
cation), and  to  give  permanence  to  these 
institutions  by  connecting  them  with  the 
cathedral  establishments ;  while  it  was 
hoped,  that  all  Churchmen  of  influence  and 
education  might  be  interested  in  the  care 
and  promotion  of  the  system,  by  the  forma- 
tion of  diocesan  boards  of  education.  This 
important  movement  took  place  in  the  year 
1838 ;  and  though  the  results,  as  far  as  it 
has  operated,  have  been  beneficial  to  the 
cause  of  education,  yet  it  must  be  confessed 
that  the  success  of  the  scheme  Las  not 
equalled  the  anticipations  of  its  benevolent 
and  enlightened  projectors.  The  pecuniary 
support  which  it  lias  met  with  has  not  been 
hitherto  sufficient  to  carry  into  execution 
the  contemplated  objects  to  the  required 
extent:  the  effect,  however,  has,  on  the 
whole,  been  considerable :  and  the  conviction 
universally  produced  on  the  public  mind 
seems  to  be,  that  without  an  appropriate 
education  to  be  given  to  the  teachers,  qualify- 
iua;  them  to  conduct  the  moral  culture  of  the 


SCHOOLS 

youthful  mind,  aH  efforts  at  useful  instruc- 
tion of  the  poor  will  be  illusory ;  and  that 
this  is  an  object  which  must,  at  all  risks- 
and  all  costs,  be  kept  in  view.  Nevertheless, 
no  one  can  fail  to  see  the  difficulty  which 
the  circumstances  of  this  country  cast  in  the 
way  of  any  training  system :  in  particular, 
the  acquirements  of  the  pupils  being  of  such 
a  nature  as  will  qualify  them  for  many 
other  employments  better  remunerated  than 
the  mastership  of  a  charity  school,  it  is 
always  to  be  feared  that  the  best  and  ablest 
proficients  may  be  tempted  to  desert  the 
profession  for  which  they  have  been  edu- 
cated, to  embark  in  one  more  lucrative  and 
alluring. 

"In  the  following  year  the  government 
made  an  attempt  to  take  into  their  own 
hands  the  guidance  of  national  education. 
This  was  to  have  been  effected  by  various 
steps,  by  the  establishment  of  a  model 
school,  and  of  a  school  for  Instructors  (or 
normal  school,  as  it  was  termed)  under  the 
authority  and  direction  of  a  Committee  of 
the  Privy  Council,  who  were  constituted  a 
board  of  education,  with  a  great  latitude  of 
discretion.  The  former  rule  of  appropriat- 
ing grants  of  public  money  in  a  just  pro- 
portion to  voluntary  donations  was  to  be  no 
longer  observed  ;  but  a  centralized  sj'stem 
of  government  inspection  of  schools  and  of 
the  course  of  instruction  was  announced.  As 
these  measures  were  proposed  by  statesmen 
who  had  always  avowed  themselves  advo- 
cates and  supporters  of  what  is  termed  the 
British  and  Foreign  system,  as  they  opened 
a  door  to  the  introduction  of  a  course  of 
education  in  which  religion  'might  liave 
little  or  no  share,  and  as  they  were  joyfully 
hailed  by  that  party  in  the  country  whicti 
avowed  hostility  to  the  Church,  there  could 
be  little  doubt  on  the  mind  of  anybody  as 
to  their  tendency.  Though  the  operation 
might  have  been  gradual,  yet  no  long  time 
would  have  jiassed  before  the  Church  was 
deposed  from  one  of  its  most  important 
functions,  and  that  upon  which  its  ulterior 
usefulness  among  the  poorer  classes  mainly 
depends — the  early  instruction  cf  their 
youth.  This  must  be  regarded  as  the  great; 
crisis  of  the  education  question,  in  which 
the  sentiments  of  all  who  had  thought  or 
interested  themselves  in  the  matter  found 
expression.  The  government  plan  was 
upheld  by  those  who  wished  for  schools  in 
which  instruction  might  be  confined,  as  in 
those  of  France,  to  secular  knowledge — as 
well  as  by  those  who  advocated  the  notion 
of  dividing  religious  instruction  into  general 
and  special,  and  wished  to  communicate  the 
former  in  schools,  but  to  exclude  the  latter, 
as  bringing  into  collision  conflicting  opinions. 
The  prevailing  judgment  of  the  public  was 
indicated  by  petitions  to  parliament,  of  which 


SCHOOLS 

about  3000  were  against  tlie  proposals,  and 
about  100  in  tlieir  favour.  The  measure 
was  only  carried  in  the  House  of  Commons, 
with  all  the  weight  of  ministerial  influence, 
by  a  majority  of  two,  while  in  the  Upper 
House  resolutions  condemnatory  of  it  were 
voted  by  a  majority  of  no  less  than  111 ; 
and  an  address  was  carried  up  to  the  throne 
by  the  whole  House,  praying  her  Majesty 
not  to  enforce  a  system  which  interfered 
with  the  province  of  the  Established  Church. 
It  rarely  happens  that  upon  any  question 
the  preponderance  of  public  opinion  through- 
out all  classes  has  been  expressed  so  de- 
cidedly, and  at  the  same  time  so  deliberately. 
Its  first  result  was  of  a  very  remarlsable 
character.  The  distinguished  and  eloquent 
statesman,  the  founder  of  the  British  and 
Foreign  School  Society,  who  had  signalized 
the  whole  of  his  public  life  by  a  zealous 
and  energetic  advocacy  of  the  comprehensive 
system  of  education,  was  so  convinced  of 
the  hopelessness  of  overcoming  the  prevalent 
feeling  in  favour  of  the  Church  as  general 
instructress,  that  he  published  a  pamphlet, 
to  persuade  those  who  had  co-operated  with 
him  for  thirty  years  in  that  course  to 
acquiesce  in  the  decision  which  public 
opinion,  as  well  as  parliament,  had  pro- 
nounced against  them ;  and  urged,  with  his 
usual  force  of  argument,  that  they  would 
best  show  themselves  the  sincere  and  patri- 
otic advocates  for  the  diffusion  of  knowledge, 
by  agreeing  at  once  to  a  '  Church  Education 
Bill.' 

"  It  is  gratifying  to  contemplate  the 
moderation  with  which  the  Church  used 
the  triumph  of  opinion  declared  in  her 
favour,  and  the  substantial  proof  which 
she  gave  of  the  sincerity  of  her  zeal  for 
intellectual  improvement.  The  deplorable 
ignorance  in  which  multitudes  were  suffered 
to  grow  up  in  the  populous  manufacturing 
and  mining  districts,  and  the  inadequacy  of 
any  voluntary,  efforts  in  their  favour,  had 
been  used  as  the  great  argument  for  devolv- 
ing all  care  of  them  and  their  instruction 
upon  the  State ;  accordingly,  a  special  fund 
was  immediately  subscribed,  and  intrusted 
to  the  National  Society,  for  maintaining 
schools  in  those  populous  districts,  amount- 
ing to  not  less  than  £150,000,  five  times 
the  sum  voted  at  the  time  by  parliament 
for  the  whole  Ijingdom.  A  disposition  was 
likewise  shown  to  meet,  as  far  as  possible, 
the  views  of  the  govenmient  in  regard  to 
schools  whose  erection  had  been  aided  by 
parliamentary  grants ;  it  being  agreed  that 
they  should  be  open  to  government  inspec- 
tion, on  condition  that  the  inspectors  of 
Church  schools  were  to  be  persons  recom- 
mended by  the  archbishops  of  the  respective 
proviuces. 

"During  the  last  seven  years  the  system 


SCHOOLS 


085 


of  inspection  has  been  iu  progress  and  I 
think,  with  singular  benefit  to°tho  cause' of 
education.  The  examination  of  a  number 
of  schools  by  able  and  intelligent  observers 
(and  such  qualifications  the  inspectors 
eminently  display)  has  thrown  much  light 
upon  a  subject  in  which  there  must  ever°be 
some  practical  difficulty.  Through  a  com- 
parison of  different  cases,  it  becomes  evident 
what  methods  are  most  successful  in  practice ; 
and  it  can  be  satisfactorily  ascertained  in 
which  instances  failure  is  attributable  to  the 
plan,  and  in  which  to  the  execution.  The 
inspectors'  reports,  comprising  a  mine  of 
valuable  information,  will  be  found  in  the 
volumes  of  the  Committee  of  Council,  which 
also  communicate  a  variety  of  plans  for 
school-rooms  and  school-liouses,  directions 
useful  for  building  and  conducting  schools, 
improvements  introduced  from  time  to 
time,  and  a  large  body  of  economics  con- 
ducive to  the  improvement  of  humble 
education.  Among  all  the  truths  which 
have  been  established  upon  this  interestino- 
subject,  the  most  important  is,  that  the 
instructor  should  himself  have  received 
early  training,  not  merely  that  he  miy  be 
qualified  to  conduct  the  mechanical  process 
of  a  school,  but  may  have  sucli  acquaintance 
with  the  tempers  and  characters  of  children, 
and  such  skill  in  managing  them,  as 
experience  alone  can  confer.  Above  all,  it 
is  necessary  that  he  should  himself  be 
thoroughly  imbued  with  religious  principles, 
without  which  there  is  little  chance  of  his 
imparting  that  tone  of  Christian  discipline 
which  should  pervade  the  whole  of  his 
intercourse  with  the  scholars.  That  there 
may  not  be  wanting  a  supply  of  fit  and  able 
persons  to  fill  these  stations,  it  is  particularly 
desirable  that,  whenever  a  boy  is  dis- 
tinguished in  a  national  school  tor  ability 
and  good  disposition,  he  should  be  retained 
beyond  the  usual  age,  both  for  his  own 
improvement  and  for  the  service  of  the 
school :  a,nd  if  means  can  be  found  to  con- 
stitute him  a  stipendiary  monitor,  the  real 
benefits  of  the  monitorial  system  will  bo 
jDerceived,  without  the  objections  to  which 
it  has  been  found  liable.  Such  a  pupil  may 
have  further  instruction  after  school  hours, 
and,  if  his  manners  and  conduct  correspond 
with  his  ability,  may  become  an  apprentice 
teacher ;  he  will  then  be  qualified  as  a  recip- 
ient of  the  higher  instruction  communicated 
at  a  training  establishment  for  schoolmasters, 
or,  as  it  is  the  fashion  to  call  it,  a  normal 
school." 

It  will  be  advantageous  to  indicate  some- 
what more  in  detail  the  various  steps  by 
which  State  education  had  advanced. 

In  1832  the  sum  of  £20,000  was  voted 
for  public  education,  and  placed  at  the  dis- 
posal of  the  Treasury,  no  separate  education 


686 


SCHOOLS 


department  having  yet  been  constituted. 
This  money  was  applied  exclusively  in 
aiding  efforts  for  the  erection  of  schools, 
on  the  recommendation  of  either  the  Na- 
tional or  the  British  and  Foreign  School 
Society.  This  arrangement  continued  for 
six  years.  It  proved  highly  unsatisfactory, 
there  being  no  sufBcient  guarantee  that  the 
money  would  be  wisely  expended. 

In  1839  the  annual  vote  was  increased 
to  £30,000,  and  a  special  department  was 
created  to  superintend  its  expenditure.  This 
department  was  composed  of  a  special  Com- 
mittee of  the  Privy  Council,  aided  by  in- 
spectors and  other  ofiBcers.  The  first  thing 
which  the  department  endeavoured  to  do 
was  to  establish  a  training  college  for 
teachers,  in  which  religious  instruction  was 
to  be  upon  the  combined  system,  i.e.  it 
was  to  be  given  by  teachers  of  the  various 
religious  communions  to  which  the  students 
respectively  belonged.  This  proposal  was 
so  strongly  opposed  by  the  Church,  that  it 
had  to  be  speedily  abandoned.  It  has 
never  been  revived.  The  department  now 
resolved  to  confine  its  operations  to  subsi- 
dizing voluntary  educational  agencies,  and 
to  the  work  of  inspection.  No  grant  was 
henceforth  to  be  made  to  any  school  not 
under  government  inspection.  Further 
minutes  required  that  in  all  State-aided 
schools  the  Bible  should  be  read,  and  a 
"  conscience  clause  "  recognised. 

In  1840  was  formed  what  came  to  be 
known  as  the  concordat  with  the  Church, 
by  which  the  sanction  of  the  primate  was 
necessary  for  the  appointment  of  an  in- 
spector. This  conciliated  the  Church,  before 
alarmed  by  the  Normal  School  scheme ;  but 
it  first  roused  the  suspicions  of  the  Noncon- 
formists, although  a  similar  concession  was 
afterwards  extended  to  them  by  giving  a 
power  of  veto  to  the  British  and  Foreign 
Society  in  the  appointment  of  the  inspectors 
assigned  to  their  schools  (Craik's  State  and 
Education,  p.  22). 

By  1843  the  annual  grant  had  risen  to 
£40,000.  Grants  were  now  m.ade  for  the 
first  time  towards  the  erection  of  teacher's 
houses  and  training  colleges,  and  towards 
the  provision  of  school  furniture  and  appa- 
ratus. 

The  publication  of  the  annual  reports  of 
the  inspectors  rendered  a  vast  seiTice  to 
education,  by  clearly  indicating  what  were 
the  needs  of  the  country,  the  defects  of  the 
existing  machinery,  and  the  best  ways  in 
which  those  defects  might  be  remedied. 
They  showed  in  particular  that  no  real 
improvement  could  be  effected  until  com- 
petent head-teachers  could  be  found,  and  that 
the  monitorial  system  of  Bell  and  Lancaster 
was  radically  unsound.  How  was  it  possi- 
ble that  children  could  satisfactorily  teach 


SCHOOLS 

children?  A  better  system  was  found  to 
obtain  in  Holland,  where  promising  pupils 
were  apprenticed  as  teachers  at  the  age  ot 
thirteen,  and  then  sent  to  a  training  college. 

The  important  minutes  of  1846  had  for 
their  chief  object  the  improvement  of  the 
training  of  teachers.  "  Before  any  annual 
grant  could  be  made,  the  inspector  was  to 
report  as  to  the  fitness  of  the  teacher  for 
the  training  of  apprentices ;  as  to  the  equip- 
ment and  organization  of  the  school ;  and  as 
to  the  probable  continuance  of  the  contribu- 
tion from  local  resources.  Apprentices  were 
to  he  recommended  by  the  managers  of  the- 
school,  and  must  not  be  under  thirteen  years 
of  age.  They  were  to  be  bound  by  inden- 
ture for  five  years,  and  at  the  end  of  each 
year  were  to  pass  an  examination  of  in- 
creasing difficulty.  When  these  conditions- 
were  fulfilled,  the  pupil-teacher  was  to 
receive  a  stipend  rising  from  £10  in  the  first 
to  £20  in  the  last  year  of  his  apprenticeship. 
Further,  the  teacher  under  whose  charge  he 
was  placed  was  to  receive  a  fixed  annual 
payment  in  return  for  his  training. 

This  provided  the  first  step  in  the  supply 
of  trained  teachers.  But  the  new  regulations 
went  further.  At  the  end  of  their  appren- 
ticeship pupil-teachers  were  to  be  eligible 
for  what  were  called  Queen's  scholarships 
of  £20  or  £25  a  year  at  some  training  college 
under  inspection.  They  were  to  be  selected 
by  competition ;  and  the  training  college- 
which  received  them  was  to  be  allowed  £20 
for  each  student  of  the  first  year,  £25  for 
each  student  of  the  second  year,  and  £30  for 
each  student  of  the  third  year.  By  this 
means  not  only  were  the  best  pupils  from 
the  elementary  schools  encouraged  to  pro- 
ceed to  a  more  complete  course  of  training 
in  the  practical  work  of  teaching,  but  the 
training  colleges  were  to  have  grants  of  a 
substantial  amount,  which  would  prevent 
their  having  recourse  to  a  less  promising 
class  to  recruit  their  ranks. . .  It  was  further 
provided  that  an  augmentation  grant  should 
\>6  allowed  to  teachers  who  had  been  so 
trained  in  proportion  to  the  length  of  their 
training.  The  lowest  augmentation  grant 
was  £15;  the  highest  £30"  (Craik,  pp. 
36-7). 

The  pupil-teacher  system  has  obvious 
disadvantages,  but  it  is  economical,  and  hasj 
on  the  wljole,  worked  well.  Its  weakest 
point  is  that  the  pupil-teacher  is  set  to 
teach  when  his  own  education  is  little  in 
advance  of  his  pupils,  and  is  not  allowed 
sufficient  leisure  for  carrying  on  his  own 
studies.  This  defect  has  been  to  some 
extent  remedied  in  the  schools  of  the  Lon- 
don School  Board  by  employing  the  pupil- 
teachers  only  half  the  day  in  school,  and 
leaving  them  the  other  half  for  self-im-  j 
provement.  1 


SCHOOLS 

In  1853  Capitation  r/ran!s  were  offered 
towards  the  support  of  schools  in  country 
districts  and  in  small  towns,  with  the  object 
of  securing  the  employment  of  an  efficient 
and  sufficient  staff  for  such  schools.  In 
1855  the  same  advantages  were  offered  to 
schools  in  urban  districts.  The  introduc- 
tion of  capitation  grants  marks  a  new 
departure  in  the  history  of  elementary 
education  in  England.  Hitherto  the  State 
had  merely  assisted  local  efforts ;  now  it 
largely  superseded  them. 

In  1856  the  various  branches  of  our 
educational  system  under  State  control  were 
united  and  placed  under  a  distinct  Educa- 
tion Department,  at  the  head  of  which  was 
to  be  the  Lord  President  of  the  Council 
assisted  by  a  member  of  the  Privy  Council, 
who  was  to  be  called  the  Vice-President  of 
the  Committee  of  Privy  Council  on  Edu- 
cation. 

For  some  years  after  this  elementary  edu- 
cation enjoyed  immunity  from  any  serious 
departmental  changes,  and  advanced  with 
enormous  strides.  In  1849  the  number  of 
certificated  teachers  was  only  681 ;  by 
1859  it  had  reached  6,878.  The  cumber  of 
pupil-teachers  had  increased  during  the 
same  decade  from  3,580  to  15,224.  The 
capitation  grants  had  risen  from  £22,801, 
paid  in  1854,  to  £247,691  in  1859. 

The  rapid  growth  of  the  education  grants 
and  of  the  official  machinery  needed  for 
their  administration  led,  in  1861,  to  the 
passing  of  a  revised  Code,  which  was  based 
on  the  recommendations  of  the  Duke  of 
Newcastle's  Commission,  appointed  to  in- 
quire into  the  state  of  popular  education  in 
England  in  1858. 

These  recommendations  were — 1.  that 
grants  for  elementary  education  should  be 
based  on  an  individual  examination  of  the 
children ;  2.  that  measures  should  be  taken 
for  aiding  districts  that  had  not  yet  been 
assisted  by  parliamentary  grants;  3.  that 
the  administration  of  the  grants  should 
be  simplified. 

Under  the  provisions  of  the  Eevised  Code, 
the  grants  were  divided  into  a  capitation 
payment  and  a  payment  on  the  results  of 
individual  examination  in  reading,  writing, 
and  arithmetic.  Grants  were  no  longer  to 
be  made  to  teachers  holding  certificates  of 
merit,  or  to  pupil-teachers,  and  managers 
were  to  be  left  perfectly  free  to  make  their 
own  terms  vrith  their  teachers. 

The  effects  of  the  Revised  Code  were 
most  disastrous.  The  education  given  in 
national  schools  was  immediately  and  almost 
universally  restricted  to  reading,  writing, 
and  arithmetic,  the  only  subjects  for  which 
government  grants  were  made ;  the  curri- 
culum of  the  training  colleges  was  cut 
down;     head-teachers,     finding     that    the 


SCHOOLS 


C87 


State  had  broken  faith  with  them  by  the 
withdrawal  of  their  certificate  allowances, 
left  their  profession  in  great  numbers  ;  and 
the  supply  of  pupil-teachers  fell  off  sa 
rapidly  that  some  of  the  training  colleges 
were  threatened  with  extinction  from  lack 
of  students.  Even  the  much-vaunted  sys- 
tem of  payment  by  results  has  proved  a 
questionable  good,  exposing  teachers,  as  it 
does,  to  the  temptation  to  put  a  dangerous 
pressure  on  their  pupils. 

In  1867  endeavours  were  made  to  neu- 
tralise some  of  the  mischievous  effects  of  the 
Revised  Code  by  encouraging  the  teaching 
of  subjects  beyond  those  specified  in  the  six 
standards,  and  by  increasing  the  ratio  of 
pupil-teachers  to  scholars  so  as  to  supply  a 
larger  number  of  candidates  for  admission 
into  the  training  colleges. 

By  1869  the  accommodation  in  schools 
under  government  inspection  exceeded 
2,000,000  places,  and  had  nearly  doubled 
what  it  was  in  1859.  "  About  1,300,000' 
children  were  educated  in  State-aided 
schools ;  and  of  the  £1,600,000  which  their 
education  annually  cost,  about  one-third 
was  defrayed  by  fees,  about  one-third  by 
govei-nment  grants,  and  about  one-third  by 
voluntary  subscriptions.  The  real  motive 
power  came  from  those  who  gave  the  volun- 
tary subscriptions.  They  amounted  in  all 
to  about  200,000  persons,  upon  whom  the 
main  burden  of  national  education  lay ;  and 
undoubtedly  they  had  achieved  much.  But 
on  the  other  hand  they  had  left  large  gaps. 
If  there  were  1,300,000  children  at  State- 
aided  schoolSj  there  were  at  least  1,000,000 
in  schools  which  received  no  grant,  were  not 
inspected,  and  against  which  there  was  a 
strong  presumption  that  they  were  utterly 
inefficient.  The  inspected  schools,  even  had 
they  been  filled  to  overflowing,  could  not 
hold  all  these  children  in  addition  to  their 
own  ;  but  besides  this  there  were  not  far 
from  2,000,000  more  who  ought  to  be,  but 
were  not,  at  school  at  all"  (Craik's  State 
and  Education,  p.  85). 

How  to  close  schools  that  were  not  giving 
an  efficient  education,  and  provide  schools 
that  voluntary  agencies  could  not  supply, 
were  the  problems  which  now  called  for 
solution.  A  league  called  "The  Education 
League  "  was  started  at  Birmingham  which 
advocated  the  establishment  of  free  and  un- 
sectarian  schools  by  means  of  local  rates,  and 
the  enforcement  of  the  principle  of  compul- 
sory attendance.  To  resist  these  revolu- 
tionary proposals,  "  The  Education  Union  " 
was  formed,  which  advocated  the  meeting  of 
the  educational  needs  of  the  country  by 
measures  on  the  old  lines. 

The  Education  Act  of  1870  was,  to  a 
certain  extent,  a  compromise  between  the 
principles  advocated  by   these  bodies.     Its 


€88 


SCHOOLS 


avowed  object  was   to  supplement,  not  to 
supplant,  existing,  voluntary  schools,  or,  in 
Mr.     Forster's    words,   "to    complete    the 
voluntary  system  and  to  fill  up  gaps."     The 
whole  country  was  divided  into  school  dis- 
tricts, and  each  district  was  required  to  have 
a  sufficient  supply  of  accommodation  for  the 
purposes    of    elementary    education.      No 
school  was  to  be  recognised  which  did  not 
admit  aU  children  without  requiring  atten- 
dance at  religious  instruction  or  religious 
worship.      An  inquiry  was  instituted  for 
the  purpose  of  ascertaining  the  school  accom- 
modation in  each  district,  and  six  months  of 
grace  were  allowed   for   voluntary  agency 
to  supply  any  deficiency.     If  at  the  end  of 
this  period  the  deficiency  was  not  filled  up  a 
School  Board  elected  by  the  ratepayers  was 
to  be  at  once  formed.     In  London  the  estab- 
lishment of  a  School  Board  was  insisted  upon 
at  once.     A  School  Board  was  to  hold  office 
for  periods  of  three  years,  and  was  to  have 
power  to  issue  a  precept  calling  upon  the 
rating  authority  to  raise  such  a  rate  as  might 
be  needed  for  the  execution  of  the  task  de- 
volving on  it.      School  Boards  were  also 
enabled  to  obtain  loans  from   the   Public 
"Works  Loan  Conimissioners  on  the  security 
of  the  school  fund.     AU  elementary  schools 
were  to    have  a  conscience  clause  which 
allowed  a  parent  to  withdraw  his  child  from 
any  religious  instruction  of  which  he  might 
disapprove,  and  required  that  the  religious 
instruction  should  be   given   either  at   the 
beginning  or  the  ending  of  a  school  ses- 
sion.    School  Boards  were  to  be  left  per- 
fectly free  to  give  or  not  to  give  religious 
instruction;  but   if  such  instruction   were 
given,  no  attempt  was  to  be  made  to  prose- 
lytize  the  children   to  any  religious  body, 
and  no  formula  or  catechism,  distinctive  of 
any  religious  body,  was  to  be  used  in  a 
Board  school.     The  Education  Department 
withdrew  altogether  from  the  examiuation  of 
children,   pupil-teachers,   and    students   in 
training    colleges  in  religious    knowledge. 
The  demand  of  the  Education  League  for 
universal  free    education  was  disregarded. 
School  Boards  were  to  charge  fees  on  a  scale 
approved  by  the  Education  Department,  but 
might  remit  the  whole  or  part  of  them  for 
certain  periods  in  cases  of  poverty,  and  in 
exceptionally  poor    neighbourhoods   might 
establish  free  schools.    They  were  also  in- 
vested with  power  to  pay  the  fees  of  poor 
children    attending    voluntary    schools — ^a 
power  which  was  never  largely  used,  owing 
to  jealousy  of  the  Church,  and  in  1876  was 
transferred  to  the  Guardians  of  the  Poor. 
To  secure  the  regular  attendance  of  children 
at  school,  School  Boards  were  empowered  to 
make  bye-laws  requiring  children  between 
the  ages  of  five  and  thirteen  to  attend  school, 
and  laying  down  the  conditions  on  which 


SCHOOIiS 

children  might  be  exempted  from  attendance. 
The  \yithdrawal  of  the  Department  from  the 
examination  of  elementary  schools  and  train- 
ing colleges  in  religious  knowledge  compelled 
the  Church  to  make  an  independent  pro- 
vision for  this  purpose.  Paid  inspectors  in 
religious  knowledge  were  appointed  in  most 
of  the  English  and  Welsh  dioceses,  and  the 
National  Society  undertook  the  cost  of  the 
examination  in  religious  knowledge  of  can- 
didates for  admission  into  the  training  col- 
leges of  students  resident  in  training  col- 
leges, and  of  acting  teachers.  The  adminis- 
tration of  the  National  Society's  grants  for 
these  purposes  is  now  entrusted  to  an  exam- 
ining Board  of  six  members,  two  of  whom 
are  elected  by  the  archbishops,  two  by  the 
Society,  and  two  by  the  principals  of  the 
training  colleges.  The  examiners  chosen  by 
the  Board  are  approved  by  the  two  arch- 
bishops. 

Thetperiod  of  grace  allowed  bj'  the  Act 
for  voluntary  agencies  to  overtake  the  edu- 
cational needs  of  the  country  was  largely 
used.  More  than  3000  applications  for 
building  grants  were  lodged  in  1870.  To 
meet  this  emergency  the  National  Society 
and  the  Society  for  Promoting  Christian 
Knowledge  made  very  liberal  grants,  which 
had  the  effect  of  preventing  the  establish- 
ment of  School  Boards  in  many  places  where 
they  would  otherwise  have  been  inevitable. 
Since  the  passing  of  the  Act  of  1870  the 
former  society  has  granted  over  £144,000 
for  building  and  enlarging  schools. 

By  1876  the  accommodation  in  element- 
ary schools  was  sufficient  for  about  3,500,000, 
of  which  more  than  2,000,000  school  places 
belonged  to  the  Church  of  England,  600,000 
to  British  and  other  Nonconformist  mana- 
gers, 200,000  to  Boman  Catholic  managers, 
and  more  than  550,000  to  School  Boards. 
"  The  accommodation  had  been  nearly 
doubled  between  1869  and  1876 ;  more  than 
1,600,000  places  had  been  added,  and  of 
those  about  two-thirds  were  due  to  voluntary 
agencies.  These  voluntary  agencies  had 
received  grants  in  aid  for  about  one-third 
of  the  schools  they  had  built,  the  grants 
defraying  about  one-fifth  of  the  cost  of  the 
aided  schools.  Towards  those  aided  schools 
these  voluntary  subscribers  had  contributed 
nearly  £1,300,000.  The  cost  of  the  re- 
maining two-thirds  of  their  schools  they 
had  defrayed  entirely  out  of  their  own 
pockets,  without  any  aid  from  the  State, 
and  at  an  expense  which  it  is  impossible 
to  estimate  accurately,  but  which  must 
certainly  have  raised  the  whole  expenditm'e 
from  voluntary  subscriptions  in  those  few 
years  to  something  more  than  £3,000,000, 
an  item  of  no  little  moment  when  the 
expediency  of  retaining  or  abolishing  this 
element  of  voluntary  effort  is  under  dis- 


SCHOOLS 

cussion.  The  cost  of  the  rest  of  the  new 
schools,  affording  accommodation  for  con- 
siderably more  thon  500,000  children,  had 
been  defrayed  by  School  Boards  from  the 
loans  for  which  they  had  received  sanction. 
These  amounted  to  £7,700,000,  and  would, 
when  fully  expended,  provide  for  621,000 
children"  (Craik's  State  and  Education, 
p.  109).  The  contributions  towards  the 
maintenance  of  voluntary  schools  in  1876 
amounted  to  £750,000. 

One  thing  was  yet  needed  to  complete 
the  Act  of  1870,  and  that  was  to  get  to 
school  the  children  for  whom  accommodation 
had  been  provided.  In  1876  Lord  Sandon 
brought  forward  a  bill  for  supplying  this 
defect,  and  the  same  year  saw  the  bill 
added  to  the  Statute  Book.  The  Act  of 
1876  stated  that  parents  should  be  bound 
to  provide  for  their  children's  receiving 
elementary  education  in  reading,  writing, 
and  arithmetic,  under  certain  penalties, 
and  laid  down  a  certain  minimum  of  re- 
quirements below  which  no  bye-laws  were 
to  fall.  It  also  provided  that,  with  certaia 
exceptions,  no  child  should  be  employed 
under  the  age  of  ten,  and  that  no  child 
between  ten  and  fourteen  years  of  age  should 
be  employed  without  a  certificate  of  pro- 
ficiency or  of  previous  due  attendance  at 
school.  To  extend  compulsory  attendance 
in  districts  not  under  School  Boards,  the 
Act  provided  that  School  Attendance  Com- 
mittees should  be  appointed  in  such  districts 
■with  power  to  frame  bye-laws  and  enforce 
attendance  at  school. 

The  effect  of  this  measure  upon  school- 
attendance  vras  soon  visible.  The  average 
attendance  increased  in  the  four  years 
(1876-80)  by  about  500,000. 

In  1880  the  framing  of  bye-laws,  which 
had  hitherto  been  optional  on  the  part  of 
School  Boards,  was  made  compulsory  on 
both  School  Boards  and  School  Attendance 
Committees.  The  bye-laws  vary  according 
to  the  circumstances  of  the  neighbourhoods 
to  which  they  apply,  but,  in  some  form  or 
other,  compulsoiy  attendance  now  prevails 
all  over  the  country. 

By  1885  the  school  accommodation  of  the 
country  had  risen  to  5,061,000  places,  of 
which  2,515,000  belong  to  the  Church  of 
England.  The  average  attendance  in 
Church  schools  was  1,637,000,  in  Board 
schools  1,029,000.  The  voluntary  subscrip- 
tions towards  the  maintenance  of  Church 
schools  amounted  to  nearly  £600,000.  The 
various  religious  denominations,  taken  to- 
gether, contributed  nearly  three-quarters  of 
a  million  towards  the  maintenance  of  their 
schools.  It  is  noteworthy  that  the  School 
Boards  levied  more  than  £800,000  the  same 
year  to  educate  less  than  half  of  the  number 
of  children  In  the  voluntary  schools. 


SCHOOLS 


689 


During  the  fourteen  years  ending  1883 
the  Church  contributed  for  education  In 
schools  connected  with  the  Education  De- 
partment £8,570,727,  as  against  £2,066,695 
from  all  the  other  religious  bodies  combined. 

It  has  been  estimated  that  the  total  sub- 
scriptions towards  the  mere  building  of 
voluntary  schools  amounted  by  1882  to 
£12,000,000. 

An  important  part  of  the  machinery  of 
elementary  education  is  that  which  is  em- 
ployed in  the  training  of  teachers.  In 
1835  a  grant  of  £10,000  was  made  by 
parliament  towards  the  establishment  of 
normal  schools  for  the  training  of  teachers ; 
but,  owing  to  "  the  religious  difficulty," 
this  sum  remained  unappropriated  for  some 
years.  The  department  soon  gave  up  all 
hope  of  establishing  a  college  of  its  own 
that  would  satisfy  the  religious  feelings  of 
the  nation,  and,  at  last,  determined  to  con- 
fine its  efforts  in  this  direction  to  the  sub- 
sidizing of  colleges  founded  by  private 
effort  or  by  educational  societies.  It  was 
not  till  the  Minutes  of  1846,  that  annual 
grants  were  systematically  made  to  the 
training  colleges.  By  these  Minutes,  as  we 
have  seen,  thepupil-teachersystem  was  estab- 
lished, and  exhibitions  were  granted  to  pupil- 
teachers  on  examination,  to  enable  them 
to  enter  the  training  colleges ;  teachers 
who  passed  the  examinations  prescribed 
for  students  in  training  received  allow- 
ances of  money  according  to  the  certificate 
of  merit  which  they  succeeded  in  obtaining. 
In  order  that  these  certificates  should  re- 
present practical  skill  as  well  as  attain- 
ments, it  was  decided  in  1853  that  they 
should  not  be  granted  to  students  while  in 
training,  but  only  to  ex-students  who  had 
successfully  conducted  an  elementary  school 
for  two  years.  The  certificates  were  to  be 
annually  endorsed  by  the  government  in- 
spector according  to  the  teacher's  merit, 
and  at  the  end  of  five  years  might  be  re- 
vised. 

In  1863,  the  year  after  the  introduction 
of  the  Revised  Code,  the  grants  to  training 
colleges  were  placed  on  an  entirely  new 
basis.  They  had  hitherto  been  whoUy 
prospective;  henceforth  they  were  to  be 
wholly  retrospective.  "  Sums  of  £100  for 
a  master  and  £70  for  a  mistress,  were  taken 
to  represent  the  average  cost  of  a  two  years' 
training.  These  amounts  were  to  be  paid 
to  the  Committee  of  Council  on  each  teacher 
trained ;  but  only  if  he  or  she  obtained  a 
certificate  after  being  at  the  college  two 
years,  and  worked  in  an  elementary  school 
satisfactorily  for  a  further  period  of  two 
years.  It  was  at  the  same  time  made  a 
condition  that  the  assistance  in  any  one  year 
was  not  to  exceed  75  per  cent,  of  the  cost  of 
the   Institution  during  the  preceding  year; 

2  Y 


690 


SCHOOLMEN 


neither  was  it  to  be  more  than  a  certain 
proportion  on  the  number  of  students  in 
residence  at  the  time  it  was  granted"  (TAe 
Schools  for  the  People,  p.  436).  Since  these 
important  alterations  scarcely  any  change 
has  been  made  in  the  conditions  on  which 
public  grants  of  money  are  made  to  the 
training  colleges. 

At  the  present  time  the  training  colleges 
of  the  country  afford  accommodation  for 
3,297  students.  Of  this  accommodation 
places  for  2,244  students  are  provided  in 
training  colleges  belonging  to  the  Church 
of  England.  Up  to  1884  the  voluntary  ex- 
penditure on  the  building  and  maintenance 
of  these  colleges  amounted  to  £647,134. 

Second  only  in  importance  to  elementary 
education,  is  the  education  of  the  middle 
classes.  This  has  not  yet  received  from 
the  Church  of  England  the  attention  it 
deserves,  with  the  inevitable  consequence 
that  it  is  drifting  into  other  hands.  Various 
praiseworthy  endeavours  have  been  made  to 
establish  Middle  Class  schools  in  connexion 
with  the  Church  of  England,  notably  by 
Canon  Woodard,  Canon  Holland,  and  the 
Church  Schools  Company. 

Canon  Woodard's  scheme  was  put  forth 
in  1848,  and  aimed  at  the  formation  of  a 
society  of  men,  who  should  be  united  in  the 
same  way  as  the  fellows  of  a  college,  and 
should  devote  themselves  to  the  work  of 
middle-class  education.  It  is  intended  that 
the  society  should  have  ultimately  five 
central  colleges,  each  under  a  provost  and 
fellows,  and  that  each  of  these  colleges 
should  embrace  a  series  of  schools  of  different 
grades.  Two  of  these  central  colleges, 
one  at  Lancing  and  one  at  Lichfield,  are 
already  in  existence.  The  religious  teaching 
is  not  restricted  by  a  conscience  clause. 

Canon  Holland's  scheme  was  intended  to 
provide,  by  means  of  a  limited  liability 
company,  for  the  education  of  girls  in  accord- 
ance with  the  principles  of  the  Church  of 
England.  It  has  opened  two  schools  in 
London. 

The  Church  Schools  Company  was 
founded  in  1883  under  the  patronage  of  the 
archbishops.  Its  object  is  to  establish  day 
and  boarding  schools  of  various  grades  for 
boys  and  girls  above  the  class  attending 
elementary  schools,  and  to  provide,  at  a 
moderate  cost,  a  sound  education  in  accord- 
ance with  the  principles  of  the  Church  of 
England,  the  right  of  withdrawing  a  scholar 
in  the  day  schools  from  religious  instruction 
being  reserved  to  the  parent  or  guardian. 
The  Company  has  already  started  ten 
schools,  and  gives  promise  of  meeting  a  great 
need  in  a  very  satisfactory  way.     [E.  D.] 

SCHOOLMEN.  The  title  given  to  a 
class  of  learned  theologians  who  flourished 
in  the  middle    ages.    They   derive    their 


SCHOOLMEN 

name  from  the  schools  attached  to  the 
cathedrals  or  universities  in  which  they 
lectured.  Some  make  Lanfranc  (William 
the  Conqueror's  Archbishop  of  Canterbury) 
the  first  author  of  scholastic  theology: 
others,  the  famous  Abelard;  others,  his 
master  Eoscelinus;  and  others  again  his 
pupil  Peter  Lombard.  But  the  most  dis- 
tinguished of  the  Schoolmen  lived  in  the 
next  century.  The  scholastic  theology  was 
the  first  attempt  at  forming  a  systematic 
theology.  Their  first  step  towards  a  sys- 
tematic theology  was  to  collect  the  sen- 
tences of  the  Fathers ;  the  next  step  was  to 
harmonize  them  by  reducing  them  to  prin- 
ciples. This  could  only  be  done  by  the 
application  of  philosophy  to  divinity,  for 
philosophy  vmfolds  the  principles  of  rea- 
soning. The  Schoolmen,  therefore,  had 
recourse  to  the  reigning  philosophy,  that 
of  Aristotle;  and  Thomas  Aquinas,  in  his 
Secunda  Secundas,  i.e.  the  second  part  of 
the  second  division  of  the  "  Sum  of  The- 
ology," has  given  the  best  and  clearest 
exposition  of  Aristotle's  Ethics  to  be  met 
with  out  of  Aristotle  himself.  The  great 
error  of  the  Schoolmen,  which  has  occa- 
sioned the  ruin  of  their  theology,  was  this, 
that,  instead  of  taking  the  Bible  only  for 
their  basis,  they  took  the  Church  for  their 
first  authority,  and  made  the  Bible  only  a 
part  of  the  Church's  teaching. 

The  doctrine  of  the  Schoolmen,  of  our 
deserving  grace  of  congruity,  is  censured  in 
our  13th  Article. 

The  Schoolmen  were : 

1.  Albertus  Magnus,  a  Dominican  friar, 
born  in  Suabia.  He  was  educated  in  the 
University  of  Paris,  and  was  Thomas  Aqui- 
nas's  master.  Pope  Alexander  IV.  sent 
for  him  to  Rome,  where  he  ofBoiated  as 
master  of  the  sacred  palace;  and  Urban 
IV.  forced  him  to  accept  of  the  bishopric 
of  Ratisbon.  He  died  at  Cologne  in  the 
year  1280.  Albert  wrote  a  great  number 
of  books ;  and,  in  those  days  of  ignorance, 
was  accused  of  magic,  and  of  having  a 
brazen  head,  which  gave  him  answers. 

2.  Bonaventure,  surnamed  the  Seraphic 
Doctor,  born  at  Bagnarea,  a  city  of  Tus- 
cany, in  1221.  He  entered  into  the  order 
of  the  Minims,  in  1233,  and  followed  his 
studies  in  the  University  of  Paris,  where  he 
afterwards  taught  divinity,  and  took  his 
doctor's  degree  with  St.  Thomas  Aquinas 
in  1255.  Next  year  he  was  elected  general 
of  his  order ;  and  Gregory  X.  made  him  a 
cardinal  in  1272.  He  assisted  at  the  first 
sessions  of  the  General  Council  of  Lyons, 
held  in  1279,  and  died  before  it  was  ended. 
His  works  are  very  numerous,  and  equally 
replete  with  piety  and  learning. 

3.  Thomas  Aquinas,  surnamed  the  An- 
gdical  Doctor,  was  descended  of  the  kings 


SCHOOLMEN 

of  Sicily  and  Aragoa,  and  was  born  in  the 
year  1224,  in  the  castle  of  Aquin,  which  is 
in  the  territory  of  Labord  in  Italy.  After 
having  been  educated  in  the  monastery  of 
Mount  Cassino,  he  was  sent  to  Naples, 
where  he  studied  Humanity  and  Philoso- 
phy. In  1244  he  went  to  Cologne  to 
study  under  Albertus  Magnus.  From 
thence  he  went  to  Paris,  where  he  took  his 
doctor's  degree  in  1255.  He  returned  into 
Italy  in  1263 ;  and,  after  having  taught 
Scholastic  Divinity  in  most  of  the  uni- 
versities of  that  country,  he  settled  at  last 
at  Naples.  In  1274,  being  sent  for  by 
Gregory  X.,  to  assist  in  the  Council  of 
Lyons,  he  fell  sick  on  the  road,  and  died 
in  the  monastery  of  Possanova,  near  Ter- 
racina.  Among  the  great  number  of  his 
works,  which  make  seventeen  volumes  in 
folio,  his  Summa  is  the  most  famous,  being 
a,  large  collection  of  theological  questions. 

4.  Scotus,  or  John  Duns  Scotus,  sur- 
uamed  the  Subtile  Doctor,  was  a  Scotchman 
by  birth,  and  came  to  Paris  about  the 
year  1300,  where  he  took  his  degrees,  and 
tanght  in  that  city.  He  particularly  taught 
the  immaculate  conception  of  the  Blessed 
Virgin.  Prom  Paris  he  went  to  Bologna, 
where  he  died  soon  after,  in  1308.  Ac- 
cording to  the  custom  of  the  times,  he  wrote 
many  philosophical  and  theological  works, 
in  which  he  prided  himself  upon  maintain- 
ing opinions  contrary  to  those  of  Thomas 
Aquinas.  This  gave  rise  to  the  opposite 
sects  of  the  Scottists  and  Thomists. 

5.  WiUiam  Ockham,  surnamed  the  Sin- 
gular Doctor,  was  born  in  a  village  of  that 
name,  in  the  county  of  Surrey,  in  England. 
He  was  the  head  of  the  sect  called  the 
Nominalists.  He  flourished  in  the  Uni- 
versity of  Paris  in  the  beginning  of  the 
fourteenth  century,  and  wrote  a  book  con- 
cerning the  power  of  the  Church  and  of  the 
State,  to  defend  Philip  the  Fair  against 
Pope  Boniface  VIII.  He  was  one  of  the 
grand  adversaries  of  Pope  John  XXII.,  who 
excommunicated  him  for  taking  part  mth 
the  anti-pope  Peter  of  Corbario.  He  ended 
his  days  at  Munich,  the  court  of  the  Elec- 
tor of  Bavaria,  who  had  received  him 
kindly. 

6.  Eaymond  Lully,  descended  of  an 
illustrious  family  in  Catalonia,  was  born  in 
the  island  of  Majorca  in  1236.  He  was 
of  the  order  of  the  Minims,  and  had  ac- 
quired a  great  knowledge  of  the  Oriental 
languages.  He  invented  a  new  method 
of  reasoning,  but  could  not  obtain  leave 
from  Honorius  IV.  to  teach  it  at  Rome. 
Then  he  resolved  to  execute  the  design  he 
had  long  formed  of  endeavouring  the  con- 
version of  the  Mohammedans.  Having 
gone  to  Tunis,  he  had  a  conference  ■with 
the  Saracens,  in  which  he  ran  the  risk  of 


SCREEN 


691 


his  life,  and  escaped  only  upon  condition 
he  would  go  out  of  Africa.  He  came  to 
Naples,  where  he  taught  his  method  till 
the  year  1290.  At  Genoa  he  wrote  several 
books.  From  thence  he  went  to  Paris, 
where  he  taught  his  art.  After  several 
travels  and  adventures,  he  returned  to  Ma- 
jorca, from  whence  he  went  over  into 
Africa,  where  he  was  imprisoned  by  the 
Saracens,  and  so  ill-treated,  that  he  died  of 
his  wounds.  He  had  found  out  the  secret 
of  making  a  jargon  proper  to  discourse  of 
everything,  without  learning  anything  in 
particular,  by  ranging  certain  general  terms 
under  different  classes. 

7.  Durandus,  surnamed  the  Most  re- 
solving Doctor,  was  of  St.  Pourpain,  a 
village  in  the  diocese  of  Clermont,  in  Au- 
vergne,  and  flourished  in  the  University  of 
Paris  from  1313  to  1318,  in  which  year  he 
was  named  by  the  iMpe  bishop  of  Puy, 
from  whence  he  was  transferred  to  the 
bishopric  of  Meaux,  which  he  governed  to 
the  time  of  his  death. 

8.  To  these  may  be  added  Giles,  arch- 
bishop of  Bourges,  surnamed  the  Doctor 
who  had  a  good  Foundation;  Peter  Aure- 
olus,  archbishop  of  Aix,  styled  the  Eloquent 
Doctor;  Augustin  Triumphus,  of  Ancona, 
who  wrote  the  Milleloquium  of  St.  Augus- 
tin; Albert  of  Padua;  Francis  Mairon,  of 
Digne  in  Provence;  Robert  Holkot,  an 
English  divine ;  Thomas  Bradwardine,  an 
Englishman,  Archbishop  of  Canterbury 
A.D.  1348,  surnamed  the  Profound  Doc- 
tor, author  of  a  treatise  de  Causa  Dei 
against  Pelagius ;  and  Gregory  of  Rimini, 
author  of  two  commentaries  on  the  First 
and  Second  Books  of  Sentences. — Cave's 
Hist.  Lit. ;  Haureau,  De  la  Philosophie, 
Scolastique,  ii. ;  Milman's  Hist.  Lat.  Christ. 
iv.  410 :  vi.  261,  273,  seq. ;  Hook's  Arch- 
bishops,  ix.  46-54 ;  Diet.  Nat.  Biog.  vi. 

SCOTLAND  (See  Church  in  Scot- 
land). 

SCREEN  (Fr.  ecran).  The  word  is 
evidently  derived  from  the  root  of  Latin 
cerno,  Greek  Kpivw,  to  separate.  Any 
separation  of  one  part  of  a  church  from 
another,  generally  of  light  construction, 
tabernacle  work,  open  arcading,  or  wood 
tracery.  Some  screens,  however,  are  large 
and  deep  structures,  with  only  a  wide  door 
in  the  middle,  and  carry,  or  used  to  carry, 
cathedral  organs  on  the  top,  as,  for  example, 
at  York  Minster  and  St.  Alban's,  and  musi- 
cians are  now  of  opinion  again  that  that  is 
the  best  place  for  an  organ,  though  of  course 
it  spoils  the  view  through  the  church,  and 
many  had  been  moved  in  consequence  into 
aisles  and  other  places.  The  screen,  and 
indeed  both  screens  in  nave  and  choir,  at  St. 
Alban's,  have  two  doors,  with  the  ,old  altar 
spaces  between  them.    The  screens  separat- 


692 


SCRIPTURE 


ing  side  chapels  from  the  chancel,  nave,  or 
transept,  are  usually  called  parcloses  (See 
Rood-Loft  and  Seredos).     [H.l 

SCRIPTURE  (ana  :  ypa(j)li  :  ypatinara  : 
Scriptura).     The  written  word  of  God. 

I.  "  The  Lord  said  unto  Moses,  Write  this 
for  a  memorial  in  a  book  "  (Ex.  xvii.  14) ; 
and  the  commandments  are  said  to  be  the 
writing  of  God.  But  the  idea  of  the  Scrip- 
ture as  a  whole  is  later,  being  first  mentioned 
in  2  Chron.  xxx.  5,  18  (3-in33,  Kara  ttju 
ypa(j)fiv,  LXX.).  The  Hebrew  word  however 
was  afterwards  changed,  and  the  Mikra 
(K^PD  :  Neh.  viii.  8)  became  the  equivalent 
of  the  collective  ypd(}>ai.  The  Mikra  was 
the  collection  of  the  iDooks  which  had  been 
preserved  during  the  Babylonish  captivity, 
and  brought  together  by  Ezra  on  the  return. 
Ezra  divided  the  Bible  into  three  parts  :  1. 
The  Law,  containing  the  Pentateuch,  or 
five  books  of  Moses ;  2.  The  Prophets,  con- 
taining thirteen  books ;  and  3.  The  Hagio- 
grapha,  four  books,  making  in  the  whole 
twenty-two,  the  number  of  letters  in  the 
Hebrew  alphabet,  but  which  the  Jews  now 
make  twenty-four. 

The  first  (tlie  Law)  was  divided  into 
fifty-four  sections,  for  the  several  sabbaths 
(with  the  intercalated  month),  and  these 
sections  into  verses.  The  division  into 
chapters,  which  were  originally  subdivided 
by  letters,  not  figures  as  now,  is  of  late 
date,  and  was  done  to  facilitate  the  use  of 
concordances. 

In  the  New  Testament  both  the  singular 
and  plural  of  the  Greek  word  are  used  ;  the 
former  applying  generally  to  some  particular 
passage  from  the  Old  Testament  (e.g.  St. 
Mark  xii.  10 ;  St.  John,  viii.  38 ;  Rom. 
ix.  17,  &c.) ;  the  latter  to  Scripture  collec- 
tively. Sometimes  simply  al  ypacjiai  is  used, 
(St.  Matt.  xxi.  42;  1  Cor.  xv.  3,  &c.), 
or  wacrat  at  yp<i(pai ;  sometimes  an  epithet 
is  joined  with  it,  as  aytat  (Rom.  i.  2),  or 
irpo(l>r)TiKal  (Rom.  xvi.  26).  In  the  passage 
in  2  Tim.  iii.  15,  to.  Upa.  ypd/inaTa  is 
translated  in  our  version,  "  the  Holy  Scrip- 
tures," no  doubt  rightly,  though  taken 
by  itself  the  word  might  include  the 
wliole  circle  of  Rabbinical  instruction. 
But  in  the  veiy  next  verse  is  TrSo-a 
ypad>j]  deoirveva-Tos  (Smith's  Diet.  Bible, 
1162). 

II.  With  regard  to  the  authority  of 
Scripture,  our  article  (VI.)  runs — "Holy 
Scripture  containeth  all  things  necessary  to 
salvation ;  so  that  whatsoever  is  not  read 
therein,  nor  may  be  proved  thereby,  is  not 
to  be  required  of  any  man,  that  it  should 
be  believed  as  an  article  of  the  faith,  or  be 
thought  requisite  or  necessary  to  salvation. 
In  the  name  of  the  Holy  Scripture  we  do 
understand  those  canonical  books  of  the  Old 
and  New  Testament,  of  whose  authority 


SCRIPTURE 

was  never  any  doubt  in  the  Church."    The 
list  is  then  given. 

"  And  the  other  Books  (as  Hierome  saith) 
the  Church  doth  read  for  example  of  life, 
and  instruction  of  manners  ;  but  yet  dotli 
it  not  apply  them  to  establish  any  doctrine." 
Then  follows  the  list  of  apocryphal  books. 
"  All  the  books  of  the  New  Testament,  as. 
they  are  commonly  received,  we  do  receive, 
and  account  them  canonical"  (See  Scrip- 
ture, Canon  of). 

Some  books  are  cited  in  the  Old  Tes- 
tament which  are  now  lost,  unless  the 
same  as  others,  under  different  names ;  as, 
1.  "The  Book  of  Jasher"  (Josh.  x.  13;  2 
Sam.  i.  18);  2.  "The  Book  of  the  Wars 
of  the  Lord"  (Numb.  xxi.  14);  3.  "  The 
Book  of  Chronicles  or  Days,"  containing 
the  annals  of  the  kingdoms  of  Israel  and 
Judah,  frequently  cited  in  the  Books  of 
Kings  and  Chronicles ;  4.  The  remainder 
of  Solomon's  "three  thousand  proverbs," 
and  "  a  thousand  and  five  songs,"  and  the 
whole  of  his  writings  on  natiural  history,. 
"  of  trees,"  "  of  beasts,  and  of  fowl,  and  of 
creeping  things,  and  of  fishes "  (1  Kings 
iv.  32,  33) ;  and  5.  Probably  the  Lamenta- 
tions of  Jeremiah  on  the  death  of  Josiah, 
as  this  subject  seems  not  included  in  the 
book  now  extant.  Some  think  that  the 
first,  the  Book  of  Jasher,  is  the  same  as  the 
second ;  others,  the  Books  of  Moses ;  and 
others  think  the  first  three  are  the  same, 
and  were  public  records  deposited  in  the 
house  of  God.  It  is  Very  probable  that 
the  references  to  these  books,  from  the 
sense  of  them,  were  subsequent  introduc- 
tions. For  an  account  of  the  language,  the 
translations,  &c.,  of  Holy  Scripture,  see 
Bible;  Peshito.     [H.] 

SCRIPTURE,  CANON  OF.  The  original 
meaning  of  Kav&v,  canon  (connected  with  n  Jp , 
KavT),  Kawa,  canna  [channel],  cane,  cannon), 
is  a  straight  rod,  as  a  ruler ;  and  then 
comes  the  idea  of  keeping  anything  straight ; 
and  afterwards  of  testing  straightness.  In 
its  literal  sense  the  word  occurs  in  Job 
xxxviii.  5,  for  a  measuring  line  (1p,  trnapTiov, 
linea),  and  in  Judith  xiii-6,  for  the  rod  at 
the  head  of  a  couch.  In  the  New  Testament 
it  is  used  in  two  passages  of  St.  Paul's  Epistles 
(Gal.  vi.  16;  2  Cor.  x.  13-16),  and  there, 
as  in  later  Christian  writers,  the  metaphori- 
cal use  of  the  word  is  clearly  shown.  The 
Sule,  the  Canon,  is  frequently  spoken  of, 
but  not  necessarily  the  Canon  of  Scripture. 
The  Rule  of  the  Church,  the  Rule  of  Truth, 
the  Rule  of  Faith — to  these  the  appeal  was 
made  by  the  early  Fathers  in  their  con- 
troversy with  heretics,  from  the  time  of 
Irenseus.  In  the  "Clementine  Homilies"" 
the  word  is  frequently  used  in  this  way, 
and  though  it  may  not  directly  be  applied 
to  Holy  Scripture, "yet  Scripture  would  be 


./^ 


SCKIPTUEK 

included  in  the  Rule  of  Faith  (Clem.  Horn. 
ii.  15,  18 :  Clem,  ad  Jac.  1). 

There  can  be  no  doubt  that  the  Canon  of 
Scripture  was  fixed  gradually.     In  the  first 
age  of  the  Christian  Church  the  words  of 
the  apostles  and  their  immediate  successors 
were  sufficient.     These,  together  with  the 
Old  Testament,  were  all  that  was  required. 
But  soon  a  change  took  place,  and  when  the 
immediate  disciples  of    the  Apostles   had 
passed  away,   it  was  felt  that  their   tra- 
ditional teaching  had  lost  its  direct  authority. 
Heretics  arose  who  claimed  to  be  possessed 
of  other  traditionary  rules  derived  in  succes- 
sion from  St.  Peter  or  St.  Paul  (Clem.  Alex. 
Strom,  vii.  17),  and  it  was  only  possible  to 
try  their  authority  by  documents  beyond 
the  reach  of  corruption,     'i'he  appeal  to  the 
written    word  of    the    Apostles    became 
natural  and  necessary.     A  fixed  literature, 
and  a  fixed  canon  or  rule  with  regard  to 
the    authorised  Scriptures  was    essential. 
Here,    however,    there    was    a    difficulty. 
Many  books  were  received  which  were  not 
of  apostolical  authority.     The   Epistle  of 
Barnabas,  for  instance,  was  still  read  among 
the  "  Apocryphal  Scriptures  "  in  the  time  of 
Jerome,   and  other  spurious  epistles  were 
subjoined  to  the  orthodox  books,  and  were 
used  and  quoted  from  by  the  early  writers. 
But  though  this  may  seem  astonishing,  we 
may  regard  their  use  of  those  books  in  the 
same  way  as  the  Church  of  England  regards 
the  books  of  the  Apocrypha  of  the  Old  Testa- 
ment.    They  are  allowed  to  have  an  ecclesi- 
astical use,  but  not  a  canonical  authority. 
They  are  profitable  for  instruction — for  ele- 
mentary teaching  (trToix^laa-LS  cla-ayoiyiKTi'), 
as  it  is   said  of  the  Shepherd  of  Hermas 
(Euseb.  H.  E.  iii.  31).     It  was  in  this  spirit 
that  Apocrypha  of  the  New  Testament  were 
admitted,  with  reserve,  in  many  Christian 
Churches.    Notwithstanding  this,  and  other 
difficulties   from  the  close  of  the  second 
century,  the  history  of  the  Canon  is  simple 
and  its  proof  clear.     It  is  allowed  even  by 
those  who  have  reduced  the  genuine  Apo- 
stolic works  to  the  narrowest  limits,  that 
from  the  time  of  Irenasus  the  New  Testa- 
ment was  composed  essentially  of  the  same 
Ijooks  which  we  receive  at  present,  and  that 
they  wrere  regarded  with  the  same  reverence 
as  is  now  shown  to  them.     The  history  of 
the  formation  of  the  Canon  of  the  New  Tes- 
tament may  be  divided  into  three  periods  : 
(1)  that  extending  to  the  time  of  Hegesippus, 
A.D.    70-170;     (2)  to   the    persecution  of 
Diocletian,  a.d.  170-303 ;  (3)  to  the  third 
Council  of  Chalcedon,  a.d.  303-397.     Each 
of  these  periods  marks  some  real  step  in  the 
progress  of  the  work.     The  first  includes 
the  era  of    the  separate    circulation,   and 
gradual  collection  of  the  Sacred  Writings : 
the  second  completes  the  history  of  their 


SCRIPTURE 


G93 


separation  from  the  other  ecclesiastical 
literature:  the  third  comprises  the  formal 
ratification  of  the  current  belief  by  the 
authority  of  councils  (Westcott's  Canon 
of  the  New  Test.  p.  6  seq.  and  Append.  A, 
and  Dr.  Salmon's  Introduction  to  the  New 
Testament,  2nd  edition,  which  discusses  those 
apocryphal  writings). 

II.  At  the  Council  of  Trent,  fourth  ses- 
sion, 1546,  at  which,  besides  cardinals,  there 
were  present  no  more  than  four  archbishops 
and  thirty-three  bishops,  of  which  number 
all  but  eight  were  Italians,  the  books  of  the 
Apocrypha  were  inserted  in  the  canon. 
Here  we  may  quote  the  words  of  Bishop 
Cosin : 

"  The  question  is,"  he  says,  "  whether 
ever  any  Church  or  ancient  author,  during 
these  first  ages,  can  be  showed  to  have  pro- 
fessedly made  such  a  catalogue  of  the  true 
and  authentic  books  of  Scripture,  as  the 
Council  of  Trent  hath  lately  addressed  and 
obti-uded  upon  the  world :  which  will  never 
be  done.  In  the  meanwhile  they  all 
speak  so  perspicuously  for  our  Church 
Canon,  that  there  can  be  no  denial  of  their 
agreement  herein  with  us." 

The  Apostolical  Constitutions,  which 
some  \vi'iters  erroneously  assign  to  Clement, 
bishop  of  Rome,  but  which  were  undoubtedly 
written  in  the  4th  century,  do  not  admit  in 
the  canon  those  books  which  we  call  apocry- 
phal. In  the  second  century,  we  find  that 
Justin  Martyr  never  cites  them  for  Scripture. 
Origen  and  TertuUian,  in  the  third  century, 
agree  in  rejecting  them.  In  the  fourth,  wo 
have  a  multitude  of  the  greatest  writers, 
who  are  clearly  against  this  point ;  such  as 
Athanasius,  Cyril  of  Jerusalem,  Hilary, 
Epiphanius,  Basil,  Gregory  Nazianzen, 
Chrysostom,  and  Jerome ;  besides  the 
Council  of  Nice  at  the  beginning  of  the 
century,  and  towards  the  close  of  it  the 
Council  of  Laodicea,  whose  canons  were 
incorporated  among  those  of  the  universal 
Church.  The  great  Churches  of  Jerusalem 
and  Alexandria,  of  Antioch  and  Constanti- 
nople, pronounced  on  the  same  side;  and 
even  in  the  Roman  Church  itself  we  have 
the  same  testimony  from  Gregory  I.,  as 
well  as  of  many  others  who  are  held  to  be 
its  chief  authorities.  Cardinal  Caietan,  who 
died  only  a  few  year.<!  before  the  meeting  of 
the  Council  of  Trent,  following  St.  Jerome, 
maintained  the  distinction  between  the 
canonical  and  apocryphal  books,  and  the 
influence  of  his  opinion  was  very  consider- 
able, even  at  Trent.  But  the  use  of  the 
Apocrypha  was  well  known  to  be  indispen- 
sable to  Roman  theologians,  and  if  it  were 
not  admitted  to  form  part  of  Scripture,  no 
Divine  sanction  could  be  pleaded  for  pur- 
gatory, the  canonization  of  saints,  or  the 
worship  of  images  and  relics.     In   this,  as 


G94 


SCRIPTUKES 


well  as  many  other  instances,  the  Eoman 
Churcii  has  not  scrupled  to  violate  primitive 
tradition,  in  order  to  maintain  its  own 
doctrines  and  practices.     [H.] 

SCRIPTURES,  INSPIRATION  OF 
(See  Bible ;  Sevetation).  "  All  Scripture," 
we  are  told,  "  is  given  by  inspiration  of 
Grod,"  2  Tim.  iii.  16.  (The  other  version  of 
that  text,  though  adopted  by  the  Revisers, 
seems  extremely  improbable,  as  critics  have 
pointed  out.)  Tertullian,  the  first  theologi- 
cal writer  who  employed  the  Latin  language, 
uses  the  word  "  inspiratio,"  to  express  the 
Holy  Ghost's  agency  in  the  composition  of 
Scripture.  The  Divine  inspiration,  or  the 
supernatural  influence  of  God  upon  the 
mind,  to  form  it  for  intellectual  improve- 
ment, may  be,  1.  An  inspiration  of  super- 
intendency,  by  which  God  preserves  a  writer 
commissioned  by  him  to  communicate  His 
will,  from  error  in  those  points  which  relate 
to  his  commission.  It  does  not  follow  that 
the  writer  shall  be  preserved  from  error  in 
what  relates  to  grammar,  or  natural  philo- 
sophy ;  but  he  is  preserved  from  error  in  all 
that  God  has  commissioned  him  to  reveal. 

2.  An  inspiration  of  suggestion,  which  pre- 
cedes the  former,  and  takes  place  when  God 
does,  as  it  were,  speak  directly  to  the  mind 
of  the  inspired  person,  making  such  dis- 
coveries to  it  as  it  could  not  but  by  miracle 
obtain.  This  has  been  done  in  various 
ways,  by  immediate  impression  on  the  mind, 
by  dreams  and  visions  represented  to  the 
imagination;  at  other  times  by  sounds 
formed  in  the  air,  or  by  visible  appearances. 

3.  Verbal  inspiration ;  for  which  there  is  no 
authority  or  assertion  by  the  writers  of 
Scripture.  And  it  is  clearly  contradicted 
by  slightly  different  versions  of  our  Lord's 
words  being  given  by  the  evangelists,  ex- 
actly as  persons  substantially  accurate  in 
their  recollections  would  do. 

The  New  Testament  was  written  by  a 
superintendent  inspiration.  The  Apostles 
were,  according  to  Christ's  promise,  fur- 
nished with  all  necessary  powers  for  the 
discharge  of  their  office,  by  an  extraordinary 
effusion  of  the  Holy  Spirit  upon  them  at 
the  day  of  Pentecost  (Acts  ii.  4,  &c.) ;  and 
a  second  time  (Acts  iv.  31).  We  may  assure 
ourselves  that  they  were  hereby  compe- 
tently furnished  for  all  those  services  which 
were  of  great  importance  for  the  spread  and 
edification  of  the  Church,  and  of  so  great 
difficulty  as  to  need  supernatural  assistance. 

Considering  how  uncertain  a  thing  oral 
tradition  is,  and  how  soon  the  most  public 
and  notorious  facts  are  corrupted  by  it,  it 
was  impossible  that  the  Christian  religion 
could  be  preserved  in  any  tolerable  degree 
of  purity,  without  a  written  account  of  the 
facts  and  doctrines  preached  by  the  apostles  ; 
and  yet,  on  the  other  hand,  we  can  hardly 


SCEIPTUEES 

suppose  that  God  would  suffer  a  doctrine 
introduced  in  so  extraordinary  a  manner  to  be 
corrupted  and  lost.  Many  of  the  doctrines 
which  the  apostles  delivered  in  their  writ- 
ings were  so  sublime  and  so  new,  that,  as  they 
could  not  have  been  known  at  first  other- 
wise than  by  an  inspiration  of  siu/gestion,  so 
they  would  need  an  inspiration  of  superin- 
tendency  in  delivering  an  accurate  account 
of  them. 

There  is  no  reason  to  doubt,  from  the 
promise  of  Christ,  that  such  parts  of  the 
New  Testament  as  were  written  by  the 
apostles  and  evangelists  (for  St.  Mark  vnrote 
his  gospel  instructed  by  St.  Peter,  and  St. 
Luke  instructed  by  St.  Paul)  were  written 
by  an  inspiration  of  superintendency. 
What  they  wrote  cannot  but  be  the  Word 
of  Him  who  invested  them  with  miraculous 
powers  (See  Palmer's  Hist,  of  Church,  ii.  6). 

It  is  not  to  be  thought  that  persons,  so 
eminent  for  humility,  piety,  humanity,  and 
other  virtues,  as  the  apostles  were,  would 
have  spoken  of  their  writings  as  the  words 
and  the  commands  of  the  Lord  as  the  test 
of  truth  and  falsehood,  and  gloried  so  much 
in  being  under  the  direction  of  the  Spirit, 
if  they  had  not  certainly  known  themselves 
to  be  so  in  their  writings,  as  well  as  in 
their  preaching ;  and  the  force  of  this 
argument  is  greatly  illustrated,  by  recollect- 
ing the  extraordinary  miraculous  powers 
with  which  they  were  honoured,  while 
making  exhortations  and  pretensions  of  this 
kind.  The  internal  evidence  all  points  to 
the  same. 

There  has  been  in  the  Christian  Church, 
from  its  earliest  ages,  a  constant  tradition, 
that  these  books  were  written  by  the  extra- 
ordinary assistance  of  the  Spirit,  which  must 
at  least  amount  to  superintendent  inspiration. 
With  respect  to  the  Old  Testament,  the 
books  we  have  inherited  from  the  Jews  were 
always  regarded  by  them  as  authentic  and 
inspired.  And  our  Blessed  Loi'd  and  His 
apostles  were  so  far  from  accusing  the 
Jews  of  superstition,  in  the  regard  which 
they  paid  to  the  ^mtings  of  the  Old  Testa- 
ment, or  from  charging  the  scribes  and 
Pharisees  (whom  Christ,  on  all  proper 
occasions,  censured  so  freely)  with  having 
introduced  into  the  sacred  volume  mere 
human  compositions,  that,  on  the  contrary, 
they  not  only  recommend  the  diligent  and 
constant  perusal  of  them,  as  of  the  greatest 
importance  to  men's  eternal  happiness,  but 
speak  of  them  as  Divine  oracles,  and  as 
written  by  an  extraordinary  influence  of 
the  Divine  Spirit  upon  the  minds  of  the 
authors  (Vide  St.  John  v.  39 :  x.  35 ; 
St.  Mark  xii.  24 ;  St.  Matt.  iv.  4,  7,  10 :  v. 
17,  38  :  xxi.  42 :  xxii.  29,  31,  43  :  xxiv. 
15  :  xxvi.  54,  56  ;  St.  Luke  i.  67, 69,  70  : 
X.  26,  27  •  xvi.  31 ;  Acts  iv.  25 :   xvii.  11 : 


SEA 

xviii.  24-28 ;  Rom.  iii.  2 :  xv.  4 :  xvi.  26 ; 
Gal.  iii.  8 ;  1  Tim.  v.  17,  18 ;  2  Tim.  iii. 
14-17 ;  St.  James  ii.  8 :  iv.  5 ;  1  St.  Pet. 
i.  10-12;  2  St.  Pet.  i.  19-21).  To  this 
list  may  be  added  many  other  places, — on 
the  whole,  more  than  five  himdred, — in 
whicli  the  sacred  writers  of  the  New  Testa- 
ment quote  and  argue  from  those  of  the  Old, 
in  such  a  manner  as  they  would  surely  not 
have  done,  if  they  had  apprehended  there 
were  room  to  allege  that  it  contained  at 
least  a  mixture  of  what  was  spurious  and  of 
no  authority. — Lowth  on  Inspiration ; 
Tillotson's  Sermons ;  Lee  on  Inspiration. 

SEA,  FORMS  OF  PRAYEE  TO  BE 
US  ED  AT.  These  were  added  to  the  Prayer 
Book  in  1661,  and  were  probably  written  or 
compiled  by  Bishop  Sanderson;  but  they 
were  committed  for  revision  by  convocation 
to  Stem,  bishop  of  Carlisle.  In  the  Preface 
they  are  mentioned  as  one  of  the  additions  it 
was  thought  expedient  to  make,  but  there 
is  nothing  said  of  their  origin.  The  Long 
Parliament  had  previously  published  "  A 
Supply  of  Prayers  for  the  ships  that  want 
ministers  to  pray  with  them,  agreeable  to 
the  Directory  established  by  Parliament" 
(see  Directory) ;  but  this  was  intended  to 
supersede  the  use  of  the  Prayer  Book,  which 
seems  to  have  been  retained  on  ships,  or 
else  no  prayer  at  a;ll  to  have  been  offered. 
The  form  was  not  designed  for  a  complete 
office,  and  by  the  rubric  at  the  head  of  the 
forms  the  ordinary  daily  service  is  directed 
to  be  used,  and  the  first  of  the  "  Articles  of 
"War"  runs,  "  Officers  are  to  cause  Public 
Worship  according  to  the  Liturgy  of  the 
Church  of  England  to  be  solemnly  per- 
formed in  their  ships,  and  to  take  care  that 
prayers  and  preaching  by  the  chaplains  be 
performed  diligently,  and  that  the  Lord's 
Day  be  observed." — Wheatly's  P.  B.  p.  517 ; 
Procter,  432 ;  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  527.  [H.] 

SEAL,  the,  or  sealing ;  a  title  given  to 
confirmation  in  the  Oriental  Church,  in 
accordance  with  the  expression  frequently 
used  by  St.  Paul  (Eph.  i.  13,  14:  iv.  30; 
2  Cor.  1.  21). 

SEALED  BOOKS.  By  the  Act  13  & 
14  Car.  II.  (which  ratified  the  last  re- 
vision of  the  Prayer  Book),  c.  4,  sect.  28, 
it  was  enacted  that  the  dean  and  chapter 
of  every  cathedral  and  collegiate  church 
should  obtain  under  the  great  seal  of  Eng- 
land a  true  and  perfect  printed  copy  of  the 
above-mentioned  Act  and  Prayer  Book, 
to  be  kept  by  them  in  safety  for  ever,  and 
to  be  produced  in  any  court  of  record  when 
required;  and  that  like  copies  should  be 
delivered  into  the  respective  courts  of 
Westminster,  and  the  Tower  of  London: 
which  books  so  to  be  exemplified  under 
the  great  seal,  were  to  be  examined  by 
persons  appointed  by  the  king,  and  com- 


SECULAR  CLERGY 


C95 


pared  with  the  original  book  annexed  to 
the  Act:  these  persons  having  power  to 
correct  and  amend  in  writing  any  error; 
certifying  the  examination  and  collation 
under  their  hands  and  seals :  "  which  said 
books,  and  every  one  of  them,  shall  be 
taken,  adjudged,  and  expounded  to  be 
good,  and  availaljle  in  the  law  to  all  in- 
tents and  purposes  whatsoever,  and  shall 
be  accounted  as  good  records  as  this  book 
itself  heretofore  annexed,"  &c. 

Mr.  Stephens,  in  his  edition  of  the 
Common  Prayer  Book,  with  notes,  has 
given  a  facsimile  text  of  the  original  black- 
letter  Prayer  Books,  published  after  the 
last  Review,  with  all  the  corrections  of 
the  commissioners  carefully  marked.  The 
sealed  books  which  he  collated  for  this 
purpose,  are  those  for  the  Chancery,  Queen's 
Bench,  Common  Pleas,  Exchequer,  St. 
Paul's,  Christ  Church  Oxford,  Ely,  and  the 
Tower  of  London.  An  engraving  from  a 
photograph  of  the  copy  belonging  to  Durham 
is  given  in  the  frontispiece  of  the  2nd  vol. 
of  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B. 

SECONDARIES.  A  general  name  for 
the  inferior  members  of  cathedrals,  as 
vicars  choral,  &c. ;  the  clerici  secundx 
formse,  that  is,  of  the  second'  or  lower 
range  of  stalls,  called  the  has  chceur  in 
Prance.  The  priest  vicars  and  minor 
canons  were  sometimes  included  in  the 
superior  form.  At  Chichester  the  secondary 
sang  the  daily  Mass  of  Requiem  in  the 
Lady-chapel.  Some  of  the  lay  singers  at 
Exeter  are  so  called.  Sometimes  the  term 
was  applied  to  the  assistant  priest  in  course, 
even  though  not  of  the  second  form.  At 
Hereford  the  second  vicar  who  assists  in 
chanting  the  Litany  is  the  "  secondary." 

SECRET  OF  THE  MASS.  A  prayer 
in  the  Canon  of  the  Mass  before  the  Preface, 
since  the  tenth  century,  said  "  secretly  "  in  a 
low  voice  by  the  celebrant. 

SECT  (from  seco,  Lat,  to  cut;  being 
analogous  to  the  word  schism,  derived  from 
the  Greek  o-x'f'^i  which  has  the  same 
meaning).  A  religious  community  follow- 
ing some  particular  master,  instead  of  ad- 
hering to  the  teaching  of  the  Catholic 
Church.  Thus  Calvinists  are  the  sect  fol- 
lowing Calvin ;  Wesleyans  the  sect  following 
Wesley.  We  are  to  remember  that  we  are 
expressly  forbidden  in  Scripture  thus  to  call 
any  man  master :  one  is  our  Master,  Jesus 
Christ,  the  righteous.  There  are  about  270 
sects  in  England,  some  rejoicing  in  very 
strange  names,  as  the  "  Hallelujah  Band," 
"  Recreative  Religionists,"  &c.  (See  Whit- 
aJcer's  Almanack,  1886). 

SECULAR  CLERGY.  The  clergy  at- 
tached to  monasteries  are  called  Begulars, 
as  living  under  a  "rule"  (regula);  the 
other  clergy  are   styled  Seculars,  as  living 


G96 


SEDILIA 


more  in  the  world  (sajculum).  In  our 
Church,  before  the  Eeformation,  the  number 
of  Kegulars  was  very  great ;  but,  since  the 
Eeformation,  we  have  only  had  Secular 
clergy.  The  canons  of  such  cathedrals  as 
were  not  monastic  were  called  Secular. 

SEDILIA.  Seats  near  an  altar,  almost 
universally  on  the  south  side,  for  the  min- 
isters officiating  at  the  holy  Eucharist. 
They  are  generally  three  in  number,  for 
the  celebrant,  epistoler,  and  gospeller,  but 
vary  from  one  to  five. 

SEE  (Latin,  sedes).  The  seat  of  epi- 
scopal dignity  and  jurisdiction,  where  the 
bishop  has  his  throne,  or  cathedra. 

SELAH  (n^P).  An  untranslated  He- 
brew word,  recurring  seventy-one  times  in 
the  Psalms,  and  three  times  in  Habakkuk, 
on  the  meaning  of  which  there  are  many 
opinions.  The  Rabbinical  writers  generally 
adopt  the  interpretation  of  "for  ever  and 
ever,"  or  "  continually  " ;  but  this  is  purely 
traditional  and  based  on  no  etymology.  It 
is  probably  a  direction  to  raise  the  voice,  or 
make  some  change  in  the  instrumental 
performance  at  certain  passages,  and  is 
merely  a  musical  notation,  connected  how- 
ever, as  all  proper  musical  expressions  must 
be,  with  the  sense.  But  with  regard  to  the 
different  views  of  this  hopeless  question  see 
Smith's  Diet.  Bib.     [H.] 

SEMI-AEIANS.  The  Arian  sect  was 
divided  into  two  principal  parties  ;  the  one 
of  which  adhering  more  closely  to  the 
opinion  of  their  master,  maintained  that 
the  Son  of  God  was  unlike  the  Father, 
'Ai/d/iotor,  and  of  this  party  was  Eunomius : 
the  other  party  refused  to  receive  the  word 
consubstantial,  yet  acknowledged  the  Son 
of  God  '0/Jotouo-ior,  of  a  like  substance  or 
essence  with  the  Father,  and  therefore  were 
called  Semi-Arians,  that  is,  half  Arians ; 
this  party  made  the  majority  in  the  Councils 
of  Eimini  and  Seleucia  (See  Arians). — 
Newman's  IHst.  of  Arians ;  Stubbs'  Mos- 
heim,  i.  397. 

SEMI-PELAGlANS,  or  MASSILI- 
BNSES.  A  sect  of  heretics,  who  endea- 
voured to  find  a  medium  betwixt  the  Pela- 
gians and  the  orthodox ;  they  had  their 
origin  about  430  in  France  (hence  the  name 
Massiliens,  from  Massilia,  now  Marseilles). 
Their  principal  favourers  were  Cassianus,  a 
disciple  of  Chrysostom ;  Faustus,  abbot 
of  Lirinum;  Vincentius,  a  Gallic  writer, 
whom  St.  Prosper  answered,  &c.  Their 
agreement  with  the  Pelagians  was  in  the 
power  of  free-will,  at  least  as  to  the  be- 
ginning of  faith  and  conversion,  and  to  the 
co-operation  of  God  and  man,  grace  and 
nature,  as  to  predestination,  from  fore- 
knowledge and  universal  grace,  and  the 
possibility  of  the  apostasy  of  the  saints. 
Some  of  them  also   would    modify    those 


SEMINARIES 

opinions,  and  maintained  only  the  predes- 
tination of  infants  from  a  foreknowledge 
of  the  life  they  would  lead.  The  great 
opposers  of  this  heresy  were  St.  Augustine, 
Ftilgentius,  &c.  The  original  of  the  pre- 
destinarian  heresy  in  this  age  is  denied  by 
Jansenius  and  others,  as  well  as  Protestants, 
and  looked  upon  as  a  fiction  of  the  Semi- 
Pelagians. — Newman's  Fleury,  xxvi.  24. ; 
Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  494. 

SEMINARIES  (from  Lat.  semen,  seed). 
Certain  colleges,  appointed  for  the  instruc- 
tion and  education  of  young  persons,  des- 
tined for  the  sacred  ministry.  The  first 
institution  of  such  places  is  ascribed  to 
St.  Augustine.  And  the  Council  of  Trent 
decrees  that  children  exceeding  twelve 
years  of  age  shall  be  brought  up  and  in- 
structed in  common,  to  qualify  them  for 
the  ecclesiastical  state ;  and  that  there  shall 
be  a  seminary  of  such  belonging  to  each 
cathedral,  under  the  direction  of  the  bishop. 

In  the  reign  of  Queen  Elizabeth,  the 
Roman  Catholics  projected  the  founding 
English  seminaries  abroad,  that  from 
thence  they  might  be  furnished  with  mis- 
sionaries to  perpetuate  and  increase  their 
communion.  Accordingly  the  college  of 
Douay  was  founded  in  1569,  at  the  ex- 
pense of  Philip  II.,  king  of  Spain ;  and 
Dr.  William  Allen,  an  Englishman,  was 
made  head  of  it.  In  the  year  1579,  a  col- 
lege was  founded  at  Rome  for  the  same 
purpose,  by  Gregory  XIII.,  who  settled 
4000  crowns  per  annum  for  the  subsistence 
of  the  society.  The  famous  Robert  Par- 
sons, an  English  Jesuit,  was  rector  of  this 
college.  King  Philip  founded  another  of 
these  nurseries  at  Valladolid  in  the  year 
1589,  and  one  at  Seville  in  1593.  The 
same  prince  founded  St.  Omers  in  Artois, 
A.D.  1596.  In  the  next  centrury  more 
seminaries  were  established,  at  Madrid, 
Louvain,  Li^ge,  and  Ghent. 

The  two  colleges  of  Douay  and  Rome 
received  such  great  encouragement,  that 
some  hundreds  of  priests  were  sent  off  from 
thence  into  England.  As  a  still  further 
encouragement.  Pope  Pius  V.  sent  his  brief 
to  the  students  of  these  colleges,  for  imder- 
taking  the  mission  into  England.  And 
that  they  might  act  without  clashing,  and 
with  the  better  harmony,  he  put  them  all 
under  the  direction  of  Dr.  Allen,  afterwards 
Cardinal. 

By  a  statute  of  Queen  Elizabeth  it  is 
made  a  praemunire  to  contribute  to  the 
maintenance  of  a  Popish  seminary.  And 
by  one  of  King  James  I.,  no  persons  are 
to  go,  or  be  sent,  to  Popish  seminaries,  to 
be  instructed  or  educated,  under  divers 
penalties  and  disabilities  mentioned  in  the 
statute. 

The  houses  of  the  society  Be  Propaganda 


SENTENCES 

Fide,  established  for  tlie  preparing  eccle- 
siastics for  missionaries  among  infidels  and 
heretics,  are  also  called  seminaries.  The 
principal  of  these  is  that  at  Rome,  called 
the  Apostolic  College  or  Seminary,  or  the 
seminary  De  Propaganda  Fide. 

SENTENCES,  THE.  Passages  of  Scrip- 
ture read  at  the  beginning  of  the  service. 
These  with  the  exhortation,  confession,  and 
absolution  were  added  in  1552,  the  fiist 
Prayer  Book  of  Edward  VI.  beginning 
with  the  Lord's  Prayer.  Nothing  was 
more  common  in  the  ancient  offices  of  the 
Western  Churches  than  the  use  of  verses 
or  small  portions  of  Scripture  in  various 
parts  of  the  public  service  of  the  Church  ; 
and  before  compline  a  verse  was  read  cer- 
tainly as  early  as  a.d.  820,  for  it  is  men- 
tioned by  Amalarius  {De  Fee.  Offic.  lib.  iv. 
c.  8).  The  nocturnal  office  in  the  Galilean 
Church  also  began  with  a  lesson,  and  the 
matins  and  noeturns  have  for  many  ages 
been  accounted  one  office  (Mabillon,  Liturg. 
Gall.  p.  399).  The  sentences  in  the  Holy 
Communion  office  (see  Comfortable  Words) 
are  peculiar  to  the  English  Church. — 
Palmer's  Orig.  Liturg.  i.  210  :  ii.  110.     [PI.] 

SBPTUAGESIMA.  The  Sunday  which 
in  round  numbers  is  70  days  before  Easter : 
hence  the  name.  There  being  exactly  50 
days  between  the  Sunday  next  before  Lent 
and  Easter  day  inclusive,  that  Sunday  is 
termed  Quinquagesima,  i.e.  the  50th.  And 
the  two  immediately  preceding  are  called 
from  the  next  round  numbers,  Sexagesima 
and  Septuagesima,  60th  and  70th.  Septua- 
gesima  is  really  the  63rd  day  before  Easter. 
The  observance  of  these  days  and  the 
weeks  following,  appears  to  be  as  ancient 
as  the  time  of  Gregory  the  Great.  Some 
of  the  more  devout  Christians  observed  the 
whole  time  from  the  first  of  these  Sundays 
to  Easter,  as  a  season  of  humiliation  and 
fasting,  though  the  ordinary  custom  was 
to  commence  fasting  on  Ash-Wednesday 
(See  Lent).  The  titles  of  these  days  are  all 
to  be  found  in  the  Lectionary  of  St.  Jerome 
and  in  the  Sacramentaries.  The  collect  we 
now  use  is  from  the  Sacramentary  of 
Gregory. 

SEPTDAGINT  (the  LXX. :  see  Bible). 
The  Greek  version  of  Scripture,  which  was 
received  both  by  the  Jews  and  the  primitive 
Christians.  The  causes  which  produced  it, 
the  number  and  names  of  the  translators, 
the  times  at  which  different  portions  were 
translated,  are  all  uncertain.  The  subject 
wiU  be  found  fully  discussed  in  the  article 
by  Professor  Selwyn  in  Smith's  Diet,  of 
Bible.  All  that  we  can  satisfactorily 
say  of  the  Septuagint  is,  that  the  Mosaic 
books  were  translated  into  Greek  about  285 
years  before  Christ,  to  which  the  other 
books  were  added  from  time  to  time,  especi- 


SEPULCHRE 


697 


ally  when,  on  occasion  of  the  prohibition  by 
Antioohus  Epiphanes  to  read  the  law,  the 
prophets  used  to  be  read  publicly  in  the 
synagogues,  and  on  the  restoration  of  the 
law  became  "  a  second  lesson."  It  is  gene- 
rally admitted  that  the  work  was  completed 
in  the  main  parts  prior  to  the  middle  of  the 
second  century,  before  the  birth  of  our 
Saviour ;  that  it  was  used  as  a  sort  of 
authorised  version  by  the  Jews  of  Alexan- 
dria, and  by  the  Hellenistic  Jews  in  general ; 
and  that  as  such  it  is  expressly  quoted 
nearly  eighty  times  in  the  writings  of  the 
New  Testament,  being  indirectly  referred  to 
much  more  frequently.  Dr.  Lightfoot  (not 
the  Bishop  of  Durham)  says  "  the  greatest 
authority  of  this  translation  appeareth  in 
that  the  holy  Greek  of  the  New  Testa- 
ment doth  so  much  follow  it.  For  as  God 
useth  this  translation  as  a  harbinger  to 
to  the  fetching  in  of  the  Gentiles,  so  when 
it  was  grown  into  authority  by  the  time  of 
Christ's  coming,  it  seemed  good  to  His  infi- 
nite wisdom  to  add  to  its  authority  Himself, 
the  better  to  forward  the  building  of  the 
Church.  And  admirable  it  is  to  see  with 
what  sweetness  and  harmony  the  New  Tes- 
tament doth  follow  this  translation  some- 
times beside  the  Old,  to  show  that  He  who 
gave  the  Old  can  and  may  best  expound  it 
in  the  New  "  {Worhs,  iv.  32).  But  not  all 
the  quotations  of  the  Old  Testament  in  the 
New  Testament  agree  with  the  Septuagint ; 
and  so  this  argument  must  not  be  carried 
too  far. — See  Owen  on  tlie  Septuagint: 
Hodius  de  Bib.  Textihus  Originalibus. 

In  the  article  above  referred  to  it  is  stated, 
"  The  version  is  not  minutely  accurate  in  de- 
tails "  (many  instances  are  given) ;  "  and  it 
may  be  laid  down  as  a  principle  never  to  build 
any  argument  on  words  or  phrases  of  tlie  Sep- 
tuagint without  comparing  tliem  with  the  He- 
brew. The  Greek  may  be  right ;  but  very 
often  its  variations  are  wrong."  At  the  same 
time  the  writer  urges  the  study  of  the  Sep- 
tuagint :  "  the  student  of  Scripture  can 
scarcely  read  a  chapter  without  some  bene- 
fit, especially  if  he  be  a  student  of  Hebrew, 
and  able  even  in  a  very  humble  way  to  com- 
pare the  version  with  the  original."     [H.] 

SEPTUM.  The  enclosure  of  the  holy 
table,  made  by  the  altar  rails. 

SEPULCHRE— often  called  the  Easter 
Sepulchre.  A  niche,  generally  at  the  north 
side  of  the  altar,  used  in  the  scenic  represen- 
tations of  our  Saviour's  burial  and  resurrec- 
tion, on  Good  Friday  and  Easter,  before  the 
Reformation,  and  representing  our  Lord's 
tomb,  is  called  the  Holy  Sepulchre.  It  is 
sometimes  quite  plain,  sometimes  gorgeously 
adorned;  the  general  subjects,  where  it  is 
much  decorated,  being  the  Roman  soldiers 
sleeping  on  the  base,  and  angels  censing  at 
the  top.     There  is  a  remarkably  fine  series 


698 


SEQUENCE 


of  these  in'  the  churches  of  Lincolnshire, 
and  in  Lincoln  cathedral,  perhaps  the  most 
heautiful  in  the  kingdom.     [H.l 

SEQUENCE  (See  Prosa). 

SEQUESTRATION.  This  is  a  separa- 
ting the  thing  in  controversy  from  the 
possession  of  both  the  contending  parties. 

When  a  living  becomes  void  by  the  death 
of  an  incumbent  or  otherwise,  the  ordinary 
is  to  send  out  his  sequestration,  to  have  the 
cure  supplied,  and  to  preserve  the  profits 
(after  the  expenses  deducted)  for  the  use  of 
the  successor.  Sometimes  a  benefice  is  left 
under  sequestration  for  many  years  together, 
namely,  when  it  is  of  so  small  value  that  no 
clergyman,  fit  to  serve  the  cure,  will  be  at 
the  charge  of  taking  it  by  institution :  in 
this  case,  the  sequestration  is  committed 
sometimes  to  the  curate  only,  sometimes  to 
the  curate  and  churchwardens  jointly. 

Sometimes  the  profits  of  a  living  are  se- 
questered for  neglect  of  duty :  but  that  kind 
of  sequestration  most  generally  known  and 
understood,  because  applicable  to  civil  affairs, 
is  upon  the  Queen's  (writ  to  the  bishop  ^to 
satisfy  the  debts  of  the  incumbent. 

This  is  where  a  judgment  has  been  ob- 
tained in  the  law  courts  against  a  clergy- 
man ;  and  upon  2.  fieri  facias  directed  to  the 
sheriff  to  levy  the  debt  and  damages,  he 
makes  his  return  that  the  defendant  is  a  clerk 
beneficed,  having  no  lay  fee.  Whereupon  a 
levari  facias  is  directed  to  the  bishop  to  levy 
the  same  on  his  ecclesiastical  goods,  and  by 
virtue  thereof  the  property  of  the  benefice 
shall  be  sequestered.  In  this  case,  the 
bishop  may  name  the  sequestrators  himself, 
or  may  grant  the  sequestration  to  such  per- 
sons as  shall  be  named  by  the  party  who 
obtained  the  writ. 

There  are  several  other  circumstances 
mentioned  in  books  of  ecclesiastical  law, 
under  which  sequestration  may  take  place ; 
but  it  may  be  stated  generally  that,  for  any 
damages  to  which  an  incumbent  may  be 
made  liable  by  civil  action,  the  property  of 
the  benefice  may  also  be  made  answerable 
by  the  process  of  sequestration.  But  it 
seems  that  the  bishop  is  the  party  through 
whom  this  confiscation  for  the  benefit  of  the 
creditor  must  take  place.  The  sequestration 
is  his  act,  to  which  he  is  bound  by  the 
Queen's  writ ;  and  it  has  been  held  that  a 
bill  filed  in  equity  against  sequestrators  only 
was  insufiicient  for  want  of  parties.  The 
bishop  should  be  a  party,  for  the  sequestra- 
tor is  accountable  to  him  for  what  he  re- 
ceives.-— Stephen's  Commentaries  (Black- 
stone),  vii.  4,  659. 

SERAPHIM  (D'lanB',  S.fpa'Pelii)  denotes 
an  order  of  angels  who  surround  the  throne 
of  the  Lord.  The  meaning  of  the  word  is 
extremely  doubtful  (See  Angels'). 

SERMONS  (Latin   sermones,  from   the 


SERMONS 

same  root  as  severe,  to  sow  or  propagate  ;  Gk. 
ofuXiai).  Discourses  delivered  in  public  by 
ministers  appointed  thereto  for  the  purpose 
of  religious  instruction,  and  usually  grounded 
upon  some  text  or  passage  of  Scripture. 

I.  In  the  ancient  Church,  immediately  after 
the  reading  of  the  psalms  and  lessons  out  of 
the  Scriptures,  before  the  catechumens  were 
dismissed,  followed  the  sermon,  which  the 
bishop,  or  some  other  appointed  by  him, 
made  to  the  people.  This,  being  done  in 
the  presence  of  the  catechumens,  was  there- 
fore reckoned  a  part  of  the  Missa  CatecJiti- 
menorum  or  ante-communion  service.  Such 
discourses  were  commonly  termed  homilies, 
from  the  Greek  S/iiXiai,  which  signifies  in- 
differently any  discourse  of  instruction  to 
the  people.  Among  the  Latins  they  were 
frequently  called  tractatus,  and  the  preachers 
tractatores. 

When  the  bishop  was  present  he  was  al- 
ways the  preacher,  but  in  his  absence  a  presby- 
ter, by  his  permission,  was  allowed  to  preach. 
Sometimes  several  bishops  and  presbyters 
gave  sermons  in  succession,  the  bishop,  or 
if  more  than  one  was  present,  the  chief  bishop 
speaking  last  (rfXevraios  ■navrwv  6  fViVKOTror, 
Apost.  Const,  ii.  57).  But  in  the  Roman 
Church  there  seems  to  have  been  either  great 
laxity  or  a  different  rule,  for  Sozomen  says 
that  there  were  no  sermons  delivered  in  that 
Church  during  the  5th  century  (fi  E.  vii. 
19).  This  statement  however  must  be  re- 
ceived with  caution  (see  Bingham,  xiv. 
iv.  3),  as  sermons  by  Leo,  bishop  of  Rome 
A.D.  440,  are  extant,  in  one  of  which  he 
speaks  of  his  duty  in  this  respect — ut  nostri 
nihil  desit  officii,  &c.  (Serm.  3,  de  Epipha- 
nia). 

II.  The  bishop  generally  delivered  his 
sermon  or  exhortation  from  the  steps  of  the 
altar;  presbyters  preached  from  the  pulpit 
or  ambon.  The  sermons  were  mostly  de- 
livered sitting,  a  custom  which  exists  at  the 
present  day  in  some  continental  churches, 
where  the  preacher,  if  a  bishop,  sits  until  he 
comes  to  some  important  point  in  his  dis- 
course, or  is  summing  up,  when  he  often 
springs  to  his  feet  with  action  and  energy. 
But  there  was  not,  and  never  has  been,  any 
general  rule,  and  the  preacher  stood  or  sat 
in  the  place  where  he  could  be  best  heard  by 
the  people.  The  catechumens,  and  even 
infidels,  were  allowed  to  hear  the  sermons. 
It  was  only  when  the  more  solemn  part  of 
the  service  was  about  to  be  commenced, 
that  these  were  dismissed  (See  Catechu- 
mens). 

III.  According  to  the  ancient  practice  of 
the  Church  of  England,  the  instructions  of 
the  preacher  may  be  divided  into  four  parts : 
(1)  the  announcement  of  feasts  and  holy- 
days,  and  Holy  Communion ;  (2)  the  publi- 
cation of  excommunications  (now  obsolete)i 


SERMONS 

and  other  ecclesiastical  acts  (see  Excommu- 
nication) ;  (3)  the  prayer  preparatory  to  the 
sermon  (see  Bidding  Prayer)  ;  and  (4)  the 
exposition  or  homily  itself.  The  latter,  pro- 
bably from  the  inefficiency  of  the  preachers, 
became  unpopular  in  the  middle  ages,  and  in 
the  thirteenth  centuiy  preaching  seems  to 
have  been  generally  omitted  (Palmer,  Orig. 
Liturg.  ii.  65).  In  a.d.  1281,  Peckham, 
archbishop  of  Canterbury,  in  his  Constitu- 
tions, "  found  it  necessary  to  insist  on  four 
sermons  in  the  year,  during  the  time  of  the 
Communion  Service.  It  does  not  appear  that 
any  great  alteration  took  place  for  some  time 
afterwards.  Archbishop  Arundell,  in  his 
Constitutions,  had  to  give  a  similar  order. 
In  a  book  called  the  Liber  Festivalis,  pub- 
lished in  the  reign  of  Henry  VIII.,  we  find  a 
series  of  homilies  for  all  the  holy-days  of  the 
year,  followed  by  the  "  quatuor  sermones," 
as  directed  by  Archbishop  Peckham.  They 
are  all  in  the  English  language,  but  they  do 
not  appear  to  have  been  much  used.  After 
the  Eeformation,  sermons  were  preached  at 
most  of  the  services,  and,  indeed,  preaching 
soon  became  elevated  beyond  its  proper 
sphere,  and  was  considered  by  the  Pmitans 
as  an  especial  means  of  grace.  Very  lengthy 
discourses  wei'e  given;  those  of  our  own 
divines,  such  as  Bishop  Andrewes,  Laud, 
J.  Taylor,  Bull,  &c.,  were  such  as  must 
have  taken  over  an  hour,  an  hour  and  a 
half,  or  even  longer,  in  delivery.  These 
sermons  are  elaborate  essays,  and  we  should 
imagine,  not  such  as  would  gain  the  ear  of 
the  people.  This  elaborate  and  formal  style 
of  preaching  existed  till  Wesley  and  AVhite- 
field  caused  a  revolution ;  and  whatever 
may  be  said  of  their  tenets,  it  is  certain 
that  from  that  time  greater  energy,  if  not 
carefulness  and  thought,  has  been  given  by 
ministers  to  their  seimons. 

IV.  The  frequency  of  sermons  is  a  matter 
of  much  consideration.  A  bishop  of  our 
Chm-ch  said  that  "  if  he  preached  twice  in  a 
week,  he  prated  once."  Two  sermons  in 
the  week,  according  to  his  idea,  was  above 
a  minister's  capability.  Yet  clergymen  with- 
out curates  can  now  be  compelled  by  the 
bishop  to  preach  twice  every  Sunday ;  but 
there  is  no  law  as  to  the  length  or  the 
quality  or  the  originality  of  their  sermons. 
And  the  bishop  may  even  order  a  third 
service  and  sermon  if  he  thinks  the  church 
too  small  for  the  parishioners. — 58  G.  III. 
c.  45,  and  1  &  2  Vict.  c.  106.  On  this 
point  we  may  give  a  note  written  by  Dean 
Hook,  in  the  "  Lives  of  the  Archbishops  of 
Canterbury,"  which  is  very  characteristic : 
"  The  homilies  are  not  read  now,  but  the 
principle  of  reading  homilies  is  recommended 
by  the  Spectator,  when  he  advises  the 
younger  clergy  to  read  printed  sermons 
from   the  pulpit.      This  is  not  advisable 


SEKMONS 


099' 


when  there  is  ability  to  deliver  extempore 
or  to  write  a  semion.  But  as  the  object  of 
preaching  is  to  do  good,  it  may  be  recom- 
mended when  a  pastor  finds  a  sermon  written 
by  another  calculated  to  explain  a  truth 
better  than  he  could  do  it  himself.  When 
we  look  at  the  House  of  Commons,  and  see,, 
out  of  five  (or  six)  hundred,  how  many,  as 
a  blessing  to  the  country,  are  '  dumb  dogs ' ;. 
when  we  read  the  foolish  speeches  that  are 
made,  which  would  be  imreadable  unless 
they  were  '  cooked '  for  publication  by  the 
reporter ;  when  even  of  public  men,  who  are 
obliged  to  speak,  the  number  is  small  who- 
are  really  eloquent,  we  ought  not  to  expect 
that  among  eighteen  thousand  clergy  every 
one  should  have  the  ability  to  compose  and 
deliver  more  than  a  hundred  original  sermons 
in  a  year.  It  is  remarkable,  rather,  that  on 
the  average  so  many  good  sermons  are 
delivered.  When  printed  sermons  are  used 
by  a  preacher,  he  is  using  a  homily,  the 
difierenoe  between  the  practice  of  the 
sixteenth  and  nineteenth  centuries  being, 
that  the  choice  of  the  homily  is  left  to  the- 
preacher.  One  of  the  most  eloquent  assail- 
ants of  preaching  in  a  Liberal  journal,  when 
called  upon  to  address  a  public  meeting,, 
failed  so  miserably  that  he  told  the  writer 
'he  should,  as  an  honest  man,  cease  to 
ridicule  the  clergy'"  {Lives  ef  the  Arcli- 
hishops,  vii.  212). 

V.  Charity  Sermons.  These  were  not 
known  till  the  Revolution,  before  which 
time  the  custom  of  making  public  collections 
at  the  church  doors,  or  otherwise  than  in 
the  ofiertory,  was  seldom,  if  ever,  resorted 
to.  At  that  time  the  Dissenters  commenced 
the  system  of  charity  sermons.  It  was  at 
first  regarded  as  an  invasion  of  the  Boyal 
prerogative;  but  when  the  authorities  did 
not  interfere  with  the  new  system,  the 
Church  gradually  followed  the  example, 
until  at  length  charity  seimons  have  become 
an  institution,  and  in  many  places  a  burden 
hard  to  bear  {Archbishops,  ix.  273). 

The  sermon  in  the  Church  of  England  is 
enjoined  after  the  Nicene  Creed,  according 
to  ancient  custom ;  but  nowhere  else ; 
although  it  is  mentioned  as  discretionary  in 
the  Marriage  service,  for  which  an  exhor- 
tation, there  given,  may  be  substituted. 
But  evening  sermons  have  been  customary- 
time  out  of  mind  in  most  churches.  The 
sermon  in  Queen  Elizabeth's  time  was 
preached  at  the  Chapel  Royal  in  the  after- 
noon, in  order  that  it  might  not  interfere 
with  St.  Paul's  Cross  seimon.  By  the  Act 
of  Uniformity  Amendment  Act,  1872  (the 
short  services  Act),  sermons  may  be  preached 
after  the  short  service  thereby  authorised,  or 
preceded  only  by  a  collect  or  the  Bidding 
Prayer  and  Lord's  Prayer.  Formerly  they 
could  not  except  in  certain  places,  such  as- 


700 


SERVICE 


the  University  churches. — Strype,  Annals, 
Pre/,  bk.  i.  ch.  xxiii.,  Anno  1561  (See 
Extemporary  Preaching ;  Preaching).    [H.] 

SEHVIOE.  I.  "The  common  prayers  of 
the  Church,  commonly  called  Divine  service." 
— Preface  to  the  Book  of  Common  Prayer. 
All  Divine  offices  celebrated  in  the  church 
constitute  part  of  the  Divine  service ;  that 
is,  the  outward  worship  which  all  God's 
servants  render  him.  II.  The  term  is  also 
used  in  a  technical  sense  peculiar  to  the 
English  Church,  to  signify  those  stated  parts 
of  the  Liturgy  which  are  set  to  music,  as 
distinguished  from  those  anthems  the  words 
of  which  are  not  a  matter  of  settled  regula- 
tion. The  term  is  now  generally  restricted 
to  the  Te  Deum,  and  other  canticles  in 
morning  and  evening  prayer ;  and  all  the 
parts  of  the  Communion  Service  appointed 
to  be  sung,  including  also  the  responses  to 
the  Commandments.  The  early  Church 
musicians,  however,  set  the  whole  service 
to  music  (and  hence  the  term) ;  that  is, 
the  pieces  (or  versicles  before  the  Psalms), 
the  Venite,  one  or  more  chants  for  the 
Psalms,  the  Te  Deum  and  canticles,  the 
versicles  and  responses  after  the  Creed,  the 
Amens,  the  Litany,  and  the  Communion 
Office :  also  the  Magnificat,  Nunc  Dimittis, 
&c.  The  first  perfect  sei-vice,  in  the  en- 
larged and  proper  sense,  which  exists  in  the 
Church  of  England,  is  Tallis's,  published  in 
Dr.  Boyce's  Cathedral  Music,  and  since  re- 
published and  corrected  by  a  second  edition. 
Services  are  as  old  as  the  Eefonnation,  and 
have  ever  constituted  an  integral  part  of 
the  choral  system  as  observed  in  cathedral 
churches  and  colleges. — Jebb,  Clwr.  Serv. 
20,  161. 

SEVEN  SACRAMENTS  (See  Sacra- 
ments). 

SEXAGESIMA.  The  Sunday  but  one 
before  Lent,  so-called  as  being  about  sixty 
days  before  Easter.  It  is  really  the  fifty- 
sixth  day  before  the  great  festival  (See 
Septvagesima). 

SEXTON;  from  Sacristan.  The  sex- 
ton was  originally  regarded  as  the  keeper 
of  the  holy  things  devoted  to  Divine  wor- 
ship :  he  is  appointed  by  the  minister  or 
churchwardens  according  to  custom;  and 
his  salary  is  according  to  the  custom  of 
each  parish,  or  is  settled  by  the  parish 
vestry.  In  the  case  of  Olive  v.  Ingram  it 
was  held,  that  a  woman  is  as  capable  of 
being  elected  to  this  office  as  a  man,  and 
that  women  may  have  a  voice  in  the  elec- 
tion. The  duty  of  a  sexton  is  to  keep  the 
church  and  pews  cleanly  swept  and  suf- 
ficiently aired;  to  make  graves,  and  open 
vaults  for  the  burial  of  the  dead;  to  pro- 
vide (under  the  churchwardens'  direction) 
candles,  &c.,  for  lighting  the  church  ;  bread 
and  wine,  and  other  necessaries,   for  the 


SHEWBREAD 

communion,  and  also  water  for  baptisms ; 
to  attend  the  church  during  Divine  ser- 
vice, in  order  to  open  the  pew  doors  for 
the  parishioners,  keep  out  dogs,  and  pre- 
vent disturbances,  &c.  It  has  been  held 
that  if  a  sexton  be  removed  without  suffi- 
cient cause,  a  mandamus  wiU  lie  for  his 
restitution.  But  where  it  apjjeared  that 
the  office  was  held  only  during  pleasure, 
and  not  for  life,  the  court  refused  to  inter- 
fere. The  salary,  however,  generally  de- 
pends on  the  annual  vote  erf  the  parish- 
ioners. 

SHAFT.  The  portion  of  a  pillar  between 
the  base  and  the  capital,  whether  a  single 
one  or  a  large  central  one  surrounded  by 
smaller  shafts,  as  was  common  in  fine  Early 
English  pillars  (See  Pillar). 

SHAKERS.  A  party  of  enthusiasts  left 
England  for  America  in  1774,  and  settled 
in  the  province  of  New  York,  where  the 
society  soon  increased,  and  received  the 
ludicrous  denomination  of  Shakers,  from  the 
practice  of  shaking  and  dancing.  They 
affected  to  consider  themselves  as  forming 
the  only  true  Church,  and  their  preachers 
as  possessed  of  the  apostolic  gift :  the 
wicked,  they  thought,  would  only  be 
punished  for  a  time,  except  those  who  should 
be  so  incorrigibly  depraved  as  to  fall  from 
their  Church.  They  disowned  Baptism  and 
the  Eucharist,  not  as  in  themselves  wrong, 
but  as  unnecessary  in  the  new  dispensation, 
which  they  declared  was  opening  upon  man- 
kind: and  this  was  the  Millennium,  in 
which,  however,  they  expected  that  Christ 
would  appear  personally  only  to  His  saints. 
Their  leader  was  Anna  Leese,  whom  they 
believed  to  be  the  woman  mentioned  in  the 
Apocalypse,  as  clothed  with  the  sun,  and 
the  moon  under  her  feet,  and  upon  her  head 
a  crown  of  twelve  stars.  The  successors 
of  this  elect  body  have  been,  they  say,  as 
perfect  as  she  was,  and  have  possessed,  like 
her,  unreserved  intercourse  vrith  angels  and 
departed  spirits,  and  the  power  of  impart- 
ing spiritual  gifts  (See  Blunt's  Diet.  Sects, 
558). 

SHECHINAH  (in  Aramaic  and  Neo- 
Hebrew  nmf).  The  glory  of  God,  prai- 
sentia  Dei.  It  is  not  the  cloud,  or  the  pillar 
of  fire,  or  the  glory  displayed  in  the  Taber- 
nacle and  in  the  Temple.  But  it  signifies 
majesty  of  the  Godhead,  of  which  the  burn- 
ing bush,  the  cloud  of  glory,  the  tongues  of 
fire,  &c.,  were  the  external  symbols.  A  dis- 
tinction must  thus  be  made  between  the 
Shechinah,  or  presence  of  the  Spirit  of  God 
in  man,  and  the  Shechinah  glory,  or  the 
manifestation  of  that  presence  (See  Diet, 
of  Bible,  1241).— Blunt's  Diet.  Doct.  Theol 
696.    [H.] 

SHEWBREAD.  The  name  given  to 
those   loaves  of  bread  which   the  Hebrew 


SHEINE 

priests  placed,  every  Sabbatli  day,  upon 
the  golden  table  in  the  sanctuary.  Tlie 
Hebrew  literally  signifies  bread  of  faces 
(D'3S  Dn?),  these  loaves  being  square,  and 
having,  as  it  were,  four  faces,  or  four  sides. 
They  are  called  shewbread  by  the  Greek 
and  Latin  interpreters,  because  they  were 
exposed  to  public  view  before  the  ark.  The 
table  on  which  they  were  placed  was  called 
tJie  table  of  shewbread  (See  Diet,  of  Bible). 

The  shewbread  consisted  of  twelve  loaves, 
according  to  the  number  of  the  tribes. 
These  were  served  up  hot  on  the  Sabbath 
day,  and  at  the  same  time  the  stale  ones, 
which  had  been  exposed  during  the  whole 
week,  were  taken  away.  It  was  not  lawful 
for  any  one  to  eat  of  these  loaves,  but  the 
priests  only.  David,  indeed,  compelled  by 
urgent  necessity,  broke  through  this  re- 
striction. This  offering  was  accompanied 
with  salt  and  frankincense,  which  was  burnt 
upon  the  table  at  the  time  when  they  set 
on  fresh  loaves. 

Perhaps  the  offering  of  "  oblations  "  may 
be  traced  to  this  Jewish  custom. 

SHRINE  (Sax.  serin;  Fr.  ecriii;  Ger. 
schrein,  from  Lat.  scrinium,  a  wooden  case 
for  keeping  books,  &o.).  The  place  where 
something  sacred,  or  a  relic,  is  deposited. 
Shrines  were  either  moveable  or  fixed.  Tlie 
former  were  on  certain  occasions  carried 
in  religious  processions  about  the  churcli  or 
round  the  town,  and  were  often  made  of  the 
most  splendid  and  costly  material,  and 
enriched  with  jewelrj'.  Several  are  still  in 
existence ;  one  of  the  12th  century  and 
three  of  the  13th  are  in  the  British  Museum  ; 
another  of  the  13th  century  in  the  Museum 
of  the  Society  of  Antiquaries  of  London ; 
another  of  a  little  earlier  date,  with  plates 
of  enamelled  copper,  and  engraved  with  the 
rood,  at  Shipley,  Sussex ;  and  St.  Ethel- 
bert's  at  Hereford  ornamented  with  the 
Acts  of  Becket.  On  the  Continent  they 
are  frequent,  notably  those  at  Aachen  (Aix- 
la-Ohapelle),  one  of  the  9th  century,  and 
the  "  Notre  Dame  "  of  the  12th,  the  gift  of 
Barbarossa;  and  the  shrine  of  the  three 
Kings  (the  Magi)  in  Cologne  Cathedral, 
probably  the  most  sumptuous  ever  made, 
the  value  of  the  jewels  with  which  it  is 
ornamented  being  estimated  at  £240,000. 
Fixed  shrines  were  substantial  erections, 
generally  the  tombs  of  saints,  as  those  of 
Edward  the  Confessor  in  Westminster 
Abbey,  St.  Thomas  at  Canterbury,  St. 
Eichard's  at  Chichester,  St.  Edmund's  at 
Bury,  St.  Chad's  at  Lichfield,  St.  PauHnus 
at  Rochester,  St.  Osmund's  at  Salisbury, 
&c.  The  word  shrine  is  sometimes,  but 
erroneously,  applied  to  the  chapel  in  which 
the  real  shrine  is  deposited  {Archxol.  i.  26  : 
iv.  57  ;  x.  469 ;  Parker's  Qloss.  Arch.  i.  426 ; 
Walcott's  Sac.  Arch.  538).     [H.] 


SIDESMEN 


701 


SHRIVE  (From  Sax.  scrifan,  borrowed 
from  Latin  scrihere).  (i.)  To  enjoin  or 
imix)se  a  i^enance ;  (ii.)  to  hear  a  confession. 

SHKOVE  TUESDAY.  The  day  before 
Ash- Wednesday,  so  called  in  the  Church  of 
England  from  the  old  Saxon  word  scrifan 
(see  Shrive) ;  it  being  our  duty  to  confess 
our  sins  to  God  on  that  day,  in  order  to 
receive  the  blessed  sacrament  of  the  Eucha- 
rist, and  thereby  qualify  ourselves  for  a 
more  religious  observance  of  the  holy  time 
of  Lent  immediately  ensuing.  Before  the 
Eeformation  all  people  were  obliged  to 
confess  their  sins  one  by  one  to  theii- 
parish  priests,  alter  which  they  dined  on 
pancakes  or  fritters.  The  latter  part  of 
the  custom  still  remains,  and  this  Tues- 
day is  in  many  places  called  "Pancake 
Tuesday." 

SICK,  COMMUNION  OF  (See  Com- 
munion of  the  Sick). 

SICK,  VISITATION  OF.  By  Canon  76, 
"When  any  person  is  dangerously  sick  in 
any  parish,  the  minister  or  curate,  having 
knowledge  thereof,  shall  resort  unto  him  or 
her  (if  the  disease  be  not  known,  or  probably 
suspected,  to  be  infectious),  to  instruct  and 
comfort  them  in  their  distress,  according  to 
the  order  of  the  communion  l>ook  if  he  be 
no  preacher,  or  if  he  be  a  preacher,  then  as 
he  shall  think  most  needful  and  convenient." 
And  by  the  rubric,  before  the  ofBce  for  the 
Visitation  of  the  Sick,  "  When  any  person 
is  sick,  notice  shall  be  given  thereof  to  the 
minister  of  the  imrish,  who  shall  go  to  the 
sick  person's  house,  and  use  the  ofiice  there 
appointed.  And  the  minister  shall  examine 
the  sick  person  whether  he  repent  him  truly 
of  his  sins,  and  be  in  charity  with  all  the 
world,  exhorting  him  to  forgive,  from  the 
bottom  of  his  heart,  all  persons  that  have 
offended  him ;  and  if  he  hath  offended  any 
other,  to  ask  them  forgiveness ;  and  where 
he  hath  done  injury  or  wrong  to  any  man, 
that  he  may  make  amends  to  the  utmost  of 
his  power.  And  if  he  hath  not  before  dis- 
posed of  his  goods,  let  him  then  be  ad- 
monished to  make  his  will,  and  to  declare 
his  debts  what  he  oweth,  and  what  is  owing 
to  him,  for  the  better  discharge  of  his 
conscience,  and  the  quietness  of  his  ex- 
ecutors. But  men  should  often  be  put  in 
remembrance  to  take  order  for  the  settling  of 
their  temporal  estates  while  they  are  in 
health.  And  the  minister  should  not  omit 
earnestly  to  move  such  sick  persons,  as  are 
of  ability,  to  be  liberal  to  the  poor"  (See 
Absolution,  Communion  of  Sich,  Visitation 
of  Sick). 

SIDESMEN  (Old  English,  sithesmen,  or 
sithcundmen).  It  was  usual  for  bishops  in 
their  visitations  to  summon  some  credible 
persons  out  of  every  parish,  whom  they 
examined  on  oath  concerning  the  condition 


702 


SIGNIFICAVIT 


of  the  cliurcli.  and  other  affau's  relating  to 
it.  Afterwards  these  persons  became  stand- 
ing oflBcers  iu  several  places,  especially  in 
great  cities  ;  and  when  personal  visitations 
were  a  little  disused,  and  when  it  became  a 
custom  for  the  parishioners  to  repair  the 
body  of  the  church,  which  began  about  the 
fifteenth  century,  these  officers  were  still 
more  necessary,  and  then  they  were  called 
Testes  Synodales  or  Juratores  St/nodi ;  some 
called  them  synodsmen.  and  now  they  are 
corruptly  called  sidesmen.  They  are  chosen 
every  year,  according  to  the  custom  of  the 
place,  and  their  business  is  to  assist  the 
churchwardens  in  inquiring  into  things 
relating  to  the  church,  and  making  present- 
ment of  such  matters  as  are  punishable  by 
the  ecclesiastical  laws.  Hence  they  are  also 
called  Questmen ;  but  now  tbe  whole  office, 
for  the  most  part,  is  devolved  upon  the 
churchwardens,  though  not  universally  (See 
Churchwardens). 

SIGNIFICAVIT.  The  writ  de  excom- 
inunicato  capiendo  was  called  a  significavit 
from  the  word  at  the  beginning  of  the  writ : 
Rex  vicecomiti  L.  salutem.  Significavit 
tidbis  venerdbilis  Pater,  H.  L.  Episcojpus, 
•&C.  It  is  under  this  writ  that  imprisonment 
for  contumacy  is  obtained  by  all  ecclesi- 
astical courts  from  the  civil. 

SiaN  OF  THE  CROSS  (See  Cross). 

SILVESTER,  ST.,  BISHOP  AND  CON- 
FESSOR, commemorated  on  December  31. 
He  was  made  Bishop  of  Rome  in  314,  and 
-was  summoned  to  attend  the  CouncU  of 
Aries  in  that  year,  and  later  the  Council  of 
Nicaea,  but  was  prevented  by  ill-health.  He 
was  a  man  of  great  piety,  and  is  said  to  have 
been  the  author  of  several  rites,  ceremonies, 
-and  ornaments  of  the  Roman  Church,  as  of 
matins,  palls,  mitres,  &c.  He  died  335.     [H.] 

ST.  SIMON  AND  ST.  JUDE'S  DA"X. 
A  holy-day  appointed  by  the  Church  for 
the  commemoration  of  these  saints,  ob- 
served in  our  Church,  on  the  28th.  October. 

St.  Simon  is  surnamed  the  Cananite  and 
Zelotes,  the  latter  term  (fTjXwTTjy),  peculiar 
to  St.  Luke,  being  equivalent  to  the  Aramaic 
/IX3p)  Cananite,  preserved  by  SS.  Matthew 
and  Mark.  The  Zealots  were  fanatics  con- 
spicuous for  their  fierce  advocacy  of  the 
Mosaic  ritual.  Perhaps  St.  Simon,  before 
his  call,  was  one  of  these,  or  else  gained  the 
title  from  some  fire  or  impetuosity  in  his 
temper.  He  is  not  to  be  confounded  with 
Simon  "  the  brother  of  Jesus  "  (Euseb.  H.  E. 
iii.  11),  nor  with  Symon,  the  second  bishop 
of  Jerusalem,  as  sometimes  stated. 

St.  Jude  was  likewise  one  of  the  twelve 
apostles,  and  St.  James's  brother.  He  had 
two  surnames,  viz.  Thaddeus  and  Lebbeus, 
but  there  is  considerable  difficulty  about 
the  interpretation  of  these  names.    Jerome 

translates  the  former  "  hearty,"  as  from  3?, 


SIMONY 

cor.  Thaddeus  and  Judas  have  been  sup- 
posed to  have  the  same  derivation  as  from 
nnin,  to  praise  (Wordsworth,  Greek  Test. 
St.  Matt.  X.  3;  Speaker's  Commentary/, 
ibid.).  St.  Simon  is  supposed  to  have  been 
crucified  in  Judaja  in  the  time  of  Domitian  ; 
St.  Jude  to  have  died  a  natural  death  at 
Edessa  (Nicephorus,  E.  E.  ii.  40 ;  Burton's 
Lectures,  i.  333).  Other  traditions  affirm 
that  they  both  suffered  death  in  Trajan's 
reign  (See  Diet,  of  Bible). 

SIMONY.  The  corrupt  presentation  of 
any  one  to  an  ecclesiastical  benefice  for 
money,  gift,  or  reward.  It  is  so  called 
from  the  sin  of  Simon  Magus,  who  thought 
to  have  purchased  the  power  of  conferring 
the  gift  of  the  Holy  Ghost  for  money 
(Acts  viii.  19) ;  though  the  purchasing  holy 
orders  seemed  to  approach  nearer  to  his 
offence.  It  is  by  the  canon  law  a  very 
grievous  offence,  and  is  so  much  the  more 
odious,  because,  as  Sir  Edward  Coke  ob- 
serves, it  is  ever  accompanied  with  perjury, 
for  the  presentee  is  sworn  to  have  committed 
no  simony. 

Canon  40,  "to  avoid  the  detestable  sin 
of  simony,"  provides  this  declaration  upon 
oath,  to  be  taken  by  every  ]5erson  on  being 
instituted  to  a  benefice  :  "  I  do  swear  that 
I  have  made  no  simoniacal  payment,  con- 
tract, or  promise,  directly  or  indirectly,  by 
myself,  or  by  any  other  to  my  knowledge 
or  with  my  consent,  to  any  person  or  per- 
sons whatsoever,  for  or  concerning  the  pro- 
curing or  obtaining  of  this  ecclesiastical 
place,  prefennent,  office,  or  living,  nor  will 
I  at  any  time  hereafter  perform  or  satisfy 
any  such  kind  of  payment,  contract,  or 
promise,  made  by  any  other  without  my 
knowledge  or  consent:  so  help  me  God 
through  Jesus  Christ." 

By  statute  31  Eliz.  c.  6,  for  the  avoiding 
of  simony  and  corruption,  it  is  provided 
that  all  presentations  made  for  such  con- 
sideration as  is  described  in  the  above- 
quoted  canon  shall  be  utterly  void;  and 
any  person  or  body  pohtic  or  corporate, 
presenting  to  a  benefice  for  such  consider- 
ation, shall  forfeit  two  years'  value  or  profits 
of  the  benefice,  and  the  person  procuring 
himself  to  be  so  presented  shall  be  for  ever 
disabled  from  holding  that  benefice ;  and 
any  person  who  shall  take  any  reward, 
other  than  the  usual  fees  for  admitting  or 
inducting  to  a  benefice,  shall  forfeit  two 
years'  profits  of  such  benefice ;  and  the 
admission  or  induction  shall  be  void,  and 
the  patron  may  present  again  as  if  the 
person  so  inducted  or  admitted  were  natu- 
rally dead.  Any  bargain  for  the  benefit  of 
the  patron,  or  any  of  the  patrons,  even  a 
covenant  to  marry  a  relative  of  the  patron, 
or  to  forbear  a  lawsuit,  or  tithes,  is  simony. 

By  statute  12  Anne,  st.  2,  c.  12,  if  any 


SINGING 

person  for  money  or  reward,  or  promise  of 
such,  shall  procure  in  his  own  name,  or  the 
name  of  any  other,  the  next  presentation  to 
any  living  ecclesiastical,  and  shall  be  pre- 
sented thereuix)n,  this  is  declared  to  be  a 
simoniacal  contract,  and  the  party  is  subject 
to  all  the  ecclesiastic  penalties  of  simony. 
Upon  these  statutes  many  questions  have 
arisen;  the  following  points  seem  settled: 
(1)  That  the  sale  of  an  advowson  is  not 
simoniacal,  unless  connected  with  a  corrupt 
contract  or  design  as  to  the  next  presenta- 
tion. (2)  That  to  purchase  a  next  presen- 
tation,, the  living  being  actually  vacant,  is 
open  simony  {Baher  v.  Rogers,  Cro.  Eliz. 
788 ;  Moor,  914,  S.C).  (3)  That  for  a 
clerk  to  bargain  for  the  next  presentation, 
the  incumbent  being  sick  and  about  to  die, 
a.nd  (by  the  statute  of  Queen  Anne)  to 
purchase  in  his  own  name  or  another's  the 
next  presentation,  is  simony  (JVinchcomhe 
V.  Bp.  of  Winchester,  Rob.  165).  (4)  That, 
on  the  other  hand,  a  bargain  by  any  other 
person  for  the  next  presentation  (even  if 
the  incumbent  is  in  extremis),  if  without 
the  privity  of  the  particular  clerk  afterwards 
presented,  is  not  simony  (^Fox  v.  Bp.  of 
Chester,  6  Bingham,  1 ;  3  Bligh,  N.  S.  123, 
S.C).  It  is  also  considered  law  that  if  an 
incumbent  is  presented  to  another  living  or 
is  otherwise  certain  to  vacate  one  but  is  not 
instituted,  the  prior  living  may  be  sold. 
(5)  That  if  a  simoniacal  contract  be  made 
with  the  patron,  the  clerk  presented  not 
being  privy  thereto,  the  presentation  for 
that  turn  shall  devolve  to  the  Crown ;  but 
the  clerk,  being  innocent,  does  not  otherwise 
incur  disability  {Whish  v.  Hesse,  3  Hagg. 
659 ;  B.  V.  Bp.  of  Norwich,  Cro.  Jac.  385). 

By  Act  9  Geo.  IV.  c.  94,  bonds  of 
resignation  in  certain  cases  are  rendered 
legally  valid  (See  Resignation  Bonds'). — 
■Stephen's  Oomm.  on  Blackstone,  iii.  76. 

SINGING  (See  Blusic,  Hymn,  Saying). 

SIN,  DEADLY  SIN,  AND  SIN 
AGAINST  THE  HOLY  GHOST  (Prom 
Anglo-Saxon  syn,  which  meant  a  writ 
of  error,  thus,  error  of  judgment.  It  is  a 
word  of  very  wide  signification,  including, 
VtJn,  ifuipTia,  forensic  failure ;  niJEJ',  Ttapd- 
fiacris,  transgression  of  the  boundary  of  right 
and  Avrong;  and  other  expressions  of  evil, 
especially  "IIP,  aTroaraarca,  revolt).  I.  Our 
sixteenth  Article,  headed  "Of  Sin  after 
Baptism,"  runs  thus :  "  Not  every  deadly 
sin  willingly  committed  after  baptism,  is 
sin  against  the  Holy  Ghost,  and  unpar- 
donable ;  wherefore  the  grant  of  repent- 
ance is  not  to  be  denied  to  such  as  fall 
into  sin,  after  baptism.  After  we  have 
received  the  Holy  Ghost  we  may  depart 
from  grace  given,  and  fall  into  sin,  and  by 
the  grace  of  God  (we  may)  arise  again, 
and  amend  our  lives;  and  therefore  they 


SIN 


703 


are  to  be  condemned  that  say  they  can  no 
more  sin  as  long  as  tlioy  live  here,  or  deny 
the  place  of  forgiveness  to  such  as  truly 
repent." 

This  Article  is  levelled  against  the  doc- 
trine of  the  Novatians,  who  held  cveiy  sm 
committed  after  baptism,  to  be  unpardon- 
able. This  doctrine  was  revived  by  some 
of  the  Anabaptists,  or  other  enthusiasts, 
who  sprang  up  at  the  beginning  of  the 
Reformation,  and  it  is  not  improbable  that 
the  compilers  of  the  Articles  had  an  eye 
likewise  upon  their  expressed  views.  For, 
as  the  anti-Reformers  were  wont  to  impute 
the  wild  doctrines  of  all  the  several  sorts  of 
enthusiasts  to  all  Protestants,  so  it  was 
thought  here  convenient  to  defend  our 
Church  against  the  imputation  of  any  such 
opinion. 

By  "  deadly  sin "  in  this  Article  we  are 
not  to  understand  such  sins  as  are  called 
"mortal"  in  the  Church  of  Rome,  in 
opposition  to  others  that  are  "  venial "  :  as 
if  some  sins,  though  offences  against  God, 
and  violations  of  His  law,  could  be  of  their 
own  nature  such  slight  things  that  they 
deserved  only  temporal  punishment,  and 
were  to  be  expiated  by  some  piece  of 
penance  or  devotion,  or  the  communica- 
tion of  the  merits  of  others.  The  Scrip- 
ture nowhere  teaches  us  to  think  so  slightly 
of  the  Majesty  of  God,  or  of  His  law. 
There  is  a  "  curse  "  upon  every  one  "  that 
continueth  not  in  all  things  which  are 
written  in  the  book  of  the  law  to  do  them  " 
(Gal.  iii.  10);  and  the  same  curse  must 
have  been  on  us  all,  if  Christ  had  not 
redeemed  lis  from  it :  "  the  wages  of  sin 
is  death.''  And  St.  James  asserts  that 
there  is  such  a  complication  of  all  the  pre- 
cepts of  the  law  of  God,  both  with  one 
another,  and  with  the  authority  of  the 
Lawgiver,  that  "  he  who  offends  in  one 
point  is  guilty  of  all "  (St.  James  ii.  10, 11). 
So  since  God  has  in  His  word  given  us 
such  dreadful  apprehensions  of  His  wrath, 
and  of  the  guilt  of  sin,  we  dare  not  soften 
these  to  a  degree  below  the  majesty  of  the 
eternal  God,  and  the  dignity  of  His  most 
holy  laws.  But  after  all,  we  are  far  from 
the  conceit  of  the  Stoics,  who  made  all 
sins  alike.  We  acknowledge  that  some 
sins  of  ignorance  and  infirmity  may  consist 
with  a  state  of  grace ;  which  is  either  quite 
destroyed,  or  at  least  much  eclipsed  and 
clouded,  by  other  sins,  that  are  more 
heinous  in  their  nature,  and  more  deliber- 
ately gone  about.  It  is  in  this  sense  that 
the  word  "  deadly  sin "  is  to  be  understood 
in  the  Article ;  for  though  in  the  strictness 
of  justice  every  sin  is  "deadly,"  yet  in  the 
dispensation  of  the  gospel  those  sins  only 
are  "deadly"  that  do  deeply  wound  the 
conscience,  and  that  drive  away  grace.  The 


704 


SIN 


"  seven  deadly  sins,"  according  to  dogmatic 
theology,  are  Pride,  Avarice,  Lust,  Envy, 
Gluttony,  Anger,  Sloth. 

II.  With  regard  to  the  sin  against  the 
Holy  Ghost  St.  Jerome  say-s  that  "  they 
only  are  guilty,  who,  though  in  miracles 
they  see  the  very  work  of  God,  yet  slander 
them,  and  say  that  they  are  done  by  the 
devil;  and  ascribe  to  the  operation  of  that 
evil  spmt,  and  not  to  the  Divine  jMwer,  all 
those  mighty  signs  and  wonders  which  were 
■wrought  for  the  confirmation  of  the  gos- 
pel." In  relation  to  all  other  sins,  we  are, 
as  Clement  of  Rome  observes,  "  to  fix  our 
eyes  on  the  blood  of  Christ,  which  was 
shed  for  our  salvation,  and  hath  obtained 
the  grace  of  repentance  for  the  whole 
world." 

III.  Between  mortal  and  venial  sins,  re- 
ferred to  above  as  the  especial  teaching  of 
the  Church  of  Rome,  the  distinction  is  that 
mortal  sin  is  that  sin  which  is  in  its  nature 
gross,  and  is  committed  knowingly,  wilfully, 
(deliberately ;  and  venial  sin  is  that  vmder 
which  head  are  classed  all  sins  of  ignorance 
and  negligence,  and  such  as  are  considered 
small  in  their  nature. 

It  is  difficult  to  distinguish,  in  some  in- 
stances, between  mortal  sins  and  venial  sins. 
But  they  form  two  distinct  classes  of  sin, 
differing  not  merely  in  degree,  but  in  genus 
or  kind. 

Mortal  sins  render  the  transgressors 
children  of  wrath  and  enemies  of  God; 
but  it  is  in  regard  to  venial  sins  that  the 
error  or  heresy  is  proix)unded.  It  is  stated 
that  in  this  mortal  life  even  holy  and  jus- 
tified persons  fall  into  daily  venial  sins, 
which,  nevertheless,  do  not  in  any  way 
affect  or  detract  from  their  holy  character, 
"  and  which  do  not  exclude  the  transgressor 
from  the  grace  of  God." 

It  is  here  to  be  observed  that  we  do  not 
deny  that  a  distinction  is  to  be  made  be- 
tween sins  of  greater  or  less  enormity.  But 
the  error  of  the  Romanist  is  this — that 
he  makes  the  two  classes  of  sin  to  differ 
not  only  in  enormity  and  degree,  which 
we  admit  to  be  the  case,  but  also  in  their 
nature  and  kind.  No  amount  of  venial 
sins,  according  to  Bellarmine,  would  ever 
make  a  mortal  sin. 

We  also  make  a  distinction  of  sins  :  we 
call  some  sins  deadly,  and  others  infirmi- 
ties ;  we  consider  the  commission  of  some 
sins  as  not  inconsistent  with  a  state  of 
grace,  whereas  by  others  the  Holy  Spirit 
may  be  grieved,  done  despite  unto,  and 
quenched,  so  that  the  sinner  shall  be  spi- 
ritually dead  :  he  shall  die  a  second  death. 

But  here  is  the  difference  between  us 
and  the  Romanists :  although  we  speak  of 
some  sins  as  of  less,  and  of  others  as  of 
greater  enormity,  we  consider  every  sin  to 


SI  QUIS 

be  in  its  nature  mortal ;  that  by  many 
little  sins  a  man  may  be  damned,  even  as 
a  ship  may  be  sunk  by  a  weight  of  sand  as 
well  as  by  a  weight  of  lead  ;  and  that  they 
are  not  damnable  to  us,  only  from  the 
constant  intercession  of  Christ.  Whereas 
negligences  and  ignorances,  and  sins  of 
lesser  enormity,  are  by  the  Romanists  not 
regarded  as  sins  at  all,  in  the  proper  sense 
of  the  word. 

Hence  we  are  for  ever  relying  directly 
upon  Christ  for  pardon  and  for  mercy,  while 
they  rely  upon  their  o^vn  merits.  They 
appeal  to  the  justice  of  God;  we  knowing 
that  by  His  justice  we  must  be  condemned, 
confide  in  His  mercy.  Tliey  say  that  venial 
sin  Is  not  in  itself  mortal ;  we  regard  all  sin 
as  mortal  in  itself,  but  rejoice  to  know  that 
"  if  any  man  sin  "  (any  man  in  a  state  of 
justification,  and,  on  that  account,  not 
sinning  habitually  and  wilfully)  "  we  have 
an  advocate  with  the  Father,  Jesus  Christ 
the  righteous,  and  he  is  the  propitiation 
for  our  sins." 

The  doctrine  of  the  Church  of  England 
leads  men  to  Christ,  and  nails  them  pros- 
trate to  the  foot  of  the  cross  ;  whereas  the 
Romish  doctrine,  though  taking  men  to 
Christ  in  the  first  instance,  soon  removes 
them  from  the  only  rock  of  salvation,  and 
induces  them  to  rely  upon  an  arm  of  flesh. 
Our  doctrine  lays  low  in  the  dust  all  human 
pride,  it  annihilates  every  notion  of  human 
merit,  and  exalts  the  Saviour  as  our  all  in 
all;  the  Romish  doctrine,  establishing  the 
idea  of  human  merit  and  supererogatory 
works,  drives  some  to  despair,  and  inflames 
others  with  spiritual  pride,  while  it  ter- 
minates in  practical  idolatry.  Our  doctrine 
is  primitive,  catholic,  and  scriptural,  as 
well  as  Protestant,  ever  reminding  us  that 
"  there  is  one  God,  and  one  Mediator  be- 
tween God  and  men,  the  man  Christ  Jesus ; " 
while  their  doctrine  is  mediajval,  scholastic, 
heretical,  and  opposed  to  the  truth  as  it  is 
in  Jesus. — J.  Grimm,  Stud.  u.  Krit.  iii. 

SI  QUIS  (See  Orders,  Ordination). 
In  the  Church  of  England,  before  a  person 
is  admitted  to  holy  orders,  a  notice  called 
the  "  Si  quis  "  (from  the  Latin  of  the  words 
if  any  persmi,  occurring  in  the  form)  used 
to  be,  but  is  no  longer,  published  in  the 
church  of  the  parish  where  the  candidate 
usually  resides,  in  the  following  form  : 
"  Notice  is  hereby  given,  that  A.  B.,  now 
resident  in  this  parish,  intends  to  offer 
himself  a  candidate  for  the  holy  office  of  a 
deacon  [or  priest]  at  the  ensuing  ordination 

of  the  Lord  Bishop  of ;   and   if  any 

person  knows  any  just  cause  or  impedi- 
ment, for  which  he  ought  not  to  be  ad- 
mitted into  holy  orders,  he  is  now  to  de- 
clare the  same,  or  to  signify  the  same 
forthwith  to  the  bishop." 


SISTERHOOD 

la  tlic  case  of  a  bishop,  the  Si  guts  is 
affixed  by  aa  officer  of  the  Arches  on  tlie 
door  of  Bow  Church,  and  he  then  also 
maizes  tliree  proclamations  for  opposers  to 
ap])ear,  &c.  (See  Confirmation  of  Bishops). 

SISTERHOOD.  A  body  of  woraea  in 
tlie  English  branch  of  the  Catholic  Church, 
associated  for  the  purpose  of  seeking  a  high 
degree  of  spiritual  perfection.  The  motive 
of  each  member  of  tlie  body  is  obedience  to 
a  special  call  of  Grod,  calling  her  to  glorify 
Him  by  aiming  at  a  specially  high  standard 
of  inner  life.  Ko  one  can  deny  that  God 
may  call  a  person  now,  as  He  called  the 
apostles,  and  again  a  select  number  of  the 
apostolic  band,  to  a  sjiecial  intimacy  with 
Him. 

The  outward  life  of  a  sisterhood  is  adjusted 
with  the  view  of  promoting  this  high  aim  of 
a  perfect  inner  life.  It  is  essentially  a  life  in 
a  community  as  contrasted  with  life  (either 
single  or  married)  in  a  natural  family.  And 
the  call  to  the  inner  life  is  taken  to  include 
a  call  to  this  means  of  living  that  inner  life. 
It  is  conceived  to  represent  for  women  the 
call  to  the  practical  waiting  upon  the 
promise  that  "every  one  that  hath  left 
houses,  or  brethren  or  sisters,  or  father  or 
mother,  or  children  or  lands  for  My  name's 
sake,  shall  receive  a  hundred  fold,  and  shall 
inherit  eternal  life." 

Such  a  call  must  be  very  sacred  and 
secret.  Of  its  reality  in  each  case  where  it 
is  professed,  none  but  the  individual  herself 
can  judge.  No  man  can  pretend  to  know 
what  God  hath  spoken  in  the  soul  of  another. 
Undoubtedly  mistakes  are  made,  and  a  call 
is  imagined  which  has  not  been  given,  but 
the  failure  of  the  life,  in  any  case,  to  promote 
perfection  is  not  decisive  against  the  reality 
of  the  call. 

The  special  name  usually  given  to  a 
sister's  call  is  "  vocation."  It  has  a  some- 
what pedantic  sound,  and  it  probably 
originated  from  the  foreign  associations 
surroundii^  the  sisterhood  life  when  revived 
•in  England. 

A  life  which  is  to  replace  the  ordinary 
family  life,  and  its  discipline  in  forming  the 
saintly  character,  is  necessary  under  special 
discipline,  and  its  outward  features  are 
intended  to  exhibit  the  three  principles  of 
celibacy,  poverty,  and  obedience.  These 
three  conditions  of  life  are  regarded  as  signal 
helps  to  humility,  and  to  mortification  of 
the  natural  man,  and  as  being  recommended 
by  the  Word  of  God  for  that  purpose. 
They  are  technically  called  "counsels  of  per- 
fection," as  being  voluntary,  not  obligatory, 
and  contrasted  with  precepts  of  perfection, 
such  as  almsgiving,  prayer,  and  fasting. 
At  the  same  time  it  is  not  to  be  supposed 
that  those  who,  like  Abraham,  the  friend  of 
God,  or  Moses,  the  meekest  of  men,  are 


SISTERHOOD 


705 


called  to  matrimony,  riches,  or  command, 
are  thereby  called  away  from  perfection; 
seeing  that  the  very  highest  of  all  possible 
perfections,  that  of  being  "  perfect  as  our 
heavenly  Father  is  perfect,"  is  expressly 
proiMsed  by  our  Lord  as  the  hope  and  aim 
of  every  Christian. 

These  leading  principles  of  the  outer  life 
of  a  sisterhood,  celibacy,  poverty,  and  obedi- 
ence, are  adopted  by  members  of  some  English 
sisterhoods  in  some  manner.  That  they 
are  professed  by  lifelong  vows  is  generally 
denied,  and  that  on  the  highest  authority, 
but  the  denial  is  not  always  accepted. 

They  are  carried  out  in  detail  by  a  Rule 
of  Life,  and  compliance  with  this  is  essential, 
as  long  as  a  woman  remains  a  member  of 
the  body. 

The  state  of  life  governed  by  the  rule  is 
technically  called  the  "  religious "  life,  in 
imitation  of  the  raedijeval  phraseology  of 
the  old  convents.  The  term  is  unfortunate, 
as  it  is  technically  inapplicable  to  any 
communities  except  those  having  as  an 
essential  element  of  their  rule  the  life  vows 
which  the  English  sisterhoods  repudiate. 

It  is,  moreover,  likel}'  to  be  misunderstood, 
and  to  be  regarded  as  implying  a  pharisaical 
monopoly  of  religion. 

The  members  of  a  sisterhood  alone  have 
a  right  to  the  title  of  sisters.  This  exclusive 
right  is  frequently  infringed  by  other  women, 
who  call  themselves  "  sisters "  merely 
because  they  do  some  work  like  that  done 
by  sisters.  But  the  word  denotes  a  state  of 
life,  not  the  performance  of  certain  work, 
just  as  the  word  "  deaconess "  denotes  an 
order  and  office  in  the  Church,  not  a  state  of 
life,  nor  a  special  occupation  (see  art. 
Deaconess).  Another  expression  some- 
times applied  to  members  of  a  sisterhood  is 
that  of  "  Brides  of  Christ,"  and  the  outward 
symbol  of  the  married  state,  viz.,  the  ring, 
is  generally  assumed  by  them.  This  title, 
given  in  Scripture  only  to  the  Church 
collectively,  was  conceded  to  individual 
women  devoting  themselves  to  the  love  of 
God,  by  enthusiastic  admirers  of  their 
devotion,  from  a  very  early  period.  Their 
use  of  it  has  been  justified  in  modern  times, 
as  expressing  a  theory  that  sisters  specially 
represent  that  view  of  the  whole  Church 
which  the  title  expresses.  It  will  not  easily 
be  admitted  that  sisters  alone  have  a  right  to 
this  privilege  of  representing  the  whole 
Church  in  its  highest  relation  to  its  head,  to 
the  exclusion  of  the  great  company  of 
female  saints  who  win  their  crowns  by  the 
more  arduous  path  of  ordinary  family  life, 
and  to  the  absolute  exclusion  of  all  male 
saints  whatever. 

It  seems  moreover  to  put  forward  in 
unpleasant  prominence  a  feminine  ambition 
of     engrossing    individual     affection,    and 

2  z 


706 


SISTEEHOOD 


imperils  the  commimion  and  co-operation  of 
sisterhoods  with  those  whom  they  regard  as 
"  in  the  world,"  and  not  so  attached  to  our 
Lord. 

The  gathering  of  women,  professing  such 
exalted  aims  of  inner  life,  into  communities, 
dates  from  the  4th  century.  The  aims 
existed  before,  and  were  nobly  pursued,  so 
that  family  life  is  not  incompatible  with 
entire  devotion  to  the  service  of  the  Lord ; 
but  a  rule  of  community  life  appears  to  be, 
in  most  cases,  almost  indispensable  as  an 
outward  support  to  the  inner  life.  During 
many  centuries  the  communities  of  women 
multiplied  in  Christendom,  and  were  a  most 
important  and  valuable  part  of  the  Church's 
life.  The  history  of  the  mediseval  convents 
is  a  literature  in  itself.  After  their  down- 
fall in  England  during  the  convulsions  of 
the  Eeformation  in  the  16th  century,  the 
idea  lay  dormant  in  the  English  Church 
until  the  revival  of  Catholic  principles  in  the 
19th  century.  Then  the  sisterhood  princi- 
ple also  revived.  The  first  modern  English 
sisterhood  was  the  Society  of  the  Holy 
Trinity,  founded  at  Devonport  in  1847. 
Then  followed  the  Sisters  of  St.  Mary  the 
Virgin,  at  Wantage,  in  1849;  the  Sisters  of 
the  Poor,  at  All  Saints,  Margaret  Street,  in 
1850;  the  Society  of  St.  John  Baptist,  at 
Clewer,  in  1854  ;  the  Nursing  Sisters  of  St. 
Margaret,  East  Grinstead,  in  1855 ;  the  sister- 
hood of  St.  Peter,  at  Kilburn,  in  1861 ;  and 
many  others  since. 

The  English  sisterhoods  have  not  found 
the  rule  of  any  one  of  the  ancient  orders  of 
nuns  entirely  adapted  to  their  require- 
ments. They  have  tentatively  worked  out 
provisional  systems  in  their  various  com- 
munities, but  cannot  be  said  to  have  con- 
solidated as  yet  (1886)  complete  rules. 

The  chief  points  in  the  constitution  of 
sisterhoods  have  been  stated  as  follows  : — 

The  sisters  should  have  their  voice  in  the 
appointment  of  the  Superior;  they  should 
hold  their  chapters  to  determine  internal 
matters  of  business ;  they  should  manage 
their  own  funds ;  they  should  have  a  settled 
rule,  and  should  be  governed  according  to 
this  rule,  not  by  the  mere  personal  will  of 
the  Superior — ^the  Superior  herself  acting 
according  to  rule  as  well  as  the  sisters. 
Sisterhoods  have  thus  a  constitutional,  not 
an  absolute,  government.  A  supervision 
should  be  vested  in  the  bishops,  and  the 
rule  of  a  sisterhood  should  be  sanctioned 
and  guarded  by  the  bishop  of  the  diocese. 
To  these  may  be  added  that  they  should  be 
protected  against  arbitrary  action  of  the 
bishop. 

An  essential  condition  of  healthy  outer  life 
in  a  sisterhood  is  active  work  for  God, 
especially  in  penitentiaries,  hospitals,  in 
teaching  children,  in  caring  for  God's  house. 


SISTEEHOOD 

Like  all  other  members  of  Christ,  for  whom 
He  prayed  Ijefore  His  passion,  they  must  be 
in  the  world,  though  not  of  the  world. 

They  claim  no  exemption  from  work,  but 
give  themselves  heartily  to  it,  with  excellent 
results.  The  sisterhood  will  be  no  home  of 
peace  and  unselfishness  without  activity. 
Nothing  else  redeems  them  from  the  charge 
of  selfishly  leaving  to  others  their  share  of 
the  cares  of  life  in  the  flesh.  Their  good 
work  is  not  an  end  in  itself,  but  rather  is. 
the  outcome  of  their  love  to  God,  and  done 
in  the  hope  of  being  well  pleasing  to  Him. 
All  English  sisterhoods  are  working  orders. 
The  cloistered  life  is  woefuUy  deficient  in 
the  chief  element  of  Christlikeness — ^viz., 
the  going  about  doing  good. 

Indeed  the  decadence  of  the  conventual 
system  at  the  period  of  the  Eeformation  was- 
principally  owing  to  the  growing  deficiency 
of  this  element  in  their  outer  life.  St. 
Augustine  bears  witness  to  the  same 
necessity  of  making  work  an  invariable 
factor  of  the  monastic  profession,  notably 
on  the  ground  that  persons,  who  come  from 
the  lower  ranks  of  society,  are  spiritually 
injured  by  being  raised  into  a  grade  viewed 
with  more  general  respect  than  that  from 
which  they  had  sprung,  unless  this  elevation 
were  counteracted  by  the  burden  of  diligent 
work.  The  praise  of  the  world  is  more  fatal 
than  its  frowns. 

The  spiritual  food  of  a  sisterhood  must 
be  abundant,  and  of  the  highest  order. 
Prayer,  instruction,  communion,  and  con- 
fession must  be  provided  without  stint. 
One  of  the  great  difficulties  of  sisterhoods  is 
the  obtaining  chaplains  competent  to  ad- 
minister their  spiritual  sustenance.  The 
protection  which  solemn  vows  afford  to 
female  instability  is  unquestionable.  But 
they  require  to  be  very  carefully  guarded. 
In  no  case  should  they  be  administered 
except  by  the  bishop  of  the  diocese  in. 
person,  and  that  openly.  They  should 
contain  an  express  proviso  for  their  possible 
revocation  by  him  or  his  successors.  They . 
should  be  definite  and  thoroughly  intelli- 
gible; terms,  such  as  poverty  and  obedi- 
ence, which  admit  of  vague  interpretation,, 
should  be  explained,  so  that  their  limits  are 
distinct. 

Sisters  have  no  office  in  the  Church.  They 
are  private  institutions.  Their  discipline 
would  probably  be  improved  by  the 
synodical  construction  of  a  general  rule  of 
sisterhood  life,  which  should  have  canonical 
force,  and  which  might  be  supplemented,, 
but  not  superseded,  by  the  authority  of  the 
bishop  of  the  diocese,  for  individual  sister- 
hoods. As  a  part  of  the  general  canonical 
rule,  they  might  receive  official  recognition 
by  receiving  an  ecclesiastical  order. 

The  apostolic  order  of  deaconess  is  ready  to- 


SITTING 

hand,  and  has  the  advantage  of  an  antiquity 
of  1800  years.     [B.  C] 

SITTING.  Tliis  posture  is  allowed  in 
our  Church  at  the  reading  of  the  lessons 
in  the  Morning  and  Evening  Prayer,  and 
also  of  the  first  lesson  or  Epistle  in  the 
Communion  Service,  but  at  no  other  time 
except  during  the  sennon.  Even  thus  we 
have  somewhat  relaxed  the  rule  of  the 
primitive  Church,  in  which  the  people 
stood,  even  to  hear  sermons.  Some  ultra- 
Protestant  sects  have  iiTeverently  used  sit- 
ting as  the  posture  of  receiving  the  Lord's 
supper,  which  ought  to  be  accounted  the 
act  of  deepest  devotion.  Some  Arians  in 
Poland  have  done  this  even  for  a  worse 
reason  :  i.e.  to  show  that  they  do  not  be- 
lieve Christ  to  be  God,  but  only  their 
fellow-creature. 

SLYPE.  The  name  given  to  the  passage 
lying  between  the  south  transept  and  the 
chapter-house  in  some  of  the  oldest  cathe- 
drals, as  Winchester  and  St.  Alban's ;  and 
occasionally  to  similar  passages  in  other 
parts.  At  Gloucester  there  is  one  between 
the  cathedral  and  the  deanery.     [G.] 

SOCIETIES,  CHURCH.  The  Church  it- 
self is  the  proper  channel  for  the  circula- 
tion of  the  Bible  and  Prayer  Book,  for  the 
establishment  of  missions,  and  the  erection 
of  sanctuaries ;  the  Church  acting  under 
her  bishops,  and  by  her  representatives  in 
synod.  In  the  times  when  not  only  convo- 
cations, but  diocesan  synods  were  suspended, 
it  was  found  necessary  to  establish  societies 
to  carry  on  the  work.  Now  that  convocation 
is  revived,  and  there  are  diocesan  conferences 
in  almost  every  diocese,  as  they  have  no 
practical  means  of  acting,  and  no  funds, 
these  societies  or  associations  still  exist,  and 
increase,  for  their  necessity  is  very  evident. 
They  collect  funds  and  arrange  details, 
which  it  would  be  impossible  for  com- 
mittees of  convocation  to  undertake,  unless 
they  were  enabled  by  special  subscription. 
It  must  be  observed  that  these  are  distinctly 
Church  societies,  managed  by  and  confined 
exclusively  to  members  of  the  Church  of 
England. 

The  oldest  is : — 

I.  The  Society  foe  Promoting  Chris- 
tian KNOWiiEDaE  was  founded  in  1698, 
chiefly  by  the  energy  of  Dr.  Thomas  Bray, 
who  had  been  appointed  in  1696  com- 
missary of  the  bishop  of  London  (Dr. 
Compton)  for  Maryland.  Four  laymen, 
Lord  Guilford,  Sir  H.  Mackworth,  Mr. 
Justice  Hook,  and  Colonel  Colchester,  to- 
gether with  Dr.  Bray,  attended  the  first 
meeting  held  on  March  8,  1698.  These 
were  soon  afterwards  joined  by  many  others, 
eminent  for  piety  and  zeal.  Their  objects 
were  (1)  the  education  of  the  poor ;  (2)  the 
care  of  the  colonies ;  (3)  the  printing  and 


SOCIETIES 


707 


circulating  books  of  sound  Christian  doctrine. 
These  objects  have  always  been  kept  before 
the  society.  Schools  have  been  established 
and  are  supported  in  most  parts  of  the 
country.  In  1884-5  assistance  was  given 
to  the  amount  of  £1855  towards  Sunday- 
school  buildings  giving  accommodation  for 
5,640  children.  In  consequence  of  the 
Education  Acts  of  1870  and  1874,  the 
Society  made  a  grant  of  £15,000  to  obviate 
the  necessity  of  the  estabhshment  of  the 
merely  secular  system  of  the  Board  Schools 
in  467  parishes.  The  Society  built  in  1880, 
and  supports,  St.  Katherine's  Training  Col- 
lege for  100  students,  besides  giving  grants 
to  other  training  colleges,  and  prizes  to 
students. 

The  Society  laboured  as  a  Missionary 
Society  among  the  colonies  tUl  1824,  when 
the  Society  for  the  Propagation  of  the  Gospel 
took  that  branch  entirely  off  its  hands.  But 
it  still  supports  missionary  work  and  gives 
grants  as  far  as  its  funds  wiU  allow.  For 
instance,  in  1885  £500  was  given  to  the 
Tukudh  Mission,  for  a  native  clergy ;  £2000 
to  the  Clergy  Fund  in  Colombo ;  £1000  to- 
wards the  bishopric  of  St.  John's,  Kafifraria ; 
£1000  towards  the  bishopric  of  Pretoria; 
£500  to  that  of  North  Queensland,  &c.,  &o. 
Help  has  been  given  in  sending  out  14 
missionaries,  and  grants  made  towards  can- 
didates for  orders,  readers,  &c. 

The  publications  of  the  Society  are 
very  numerous,  and  during  1885  the  sales 
amounted  to  £81,685 ;  1605  separate  grants 
of  books  were  made;  Bibles,  prayer-books, 
and  hymn-books,  &c.,  to  the  value  of  £2,400 
have  been  given  to  churches,  mission-rooms, 
Sunday  and  day  schools,  and  public  in- 
stitutions [Official  Year-hooh,  1886;  Ad- 
dresses at  the  opening  of  the  Societies'  new 
house,  1879  ;  Sewell's  "  Short  Account " 
(S.P.O.K.),  1885]. 

II.  Society  fob  PROPAGATma  the  Gos- 
pel IN  Foreign  Parts. — Dr.  Bray  on  his 
return  from  Maryland,  whither  he  had  gone 
as  commissary  for  the  bishop  of  London  (see 
preceding  section  I.),  immediately  set  to 
work  to  form  a  distinct  branch  of  the  Society, 
to  which  the  care  of  the  missionary  work 
should  be  committed.  After  much  difficulty. 
Dr.  Bray  and  his  friends,  backed  by  the 
powerful  aid  of  Archbishop  Tenison,  Bishop 
Compton  and  other  bishops,  and  of  the  lower 
house  of  the  Convocation  of  Canterbury, 
succeeded  in  procuring,  on  June  15,  1701,  a 
charter  under  the  seal  of  William  III.  con- 
stituting ninety-six  persons  the  first  mem- 
bers of  a  corporate  Society  for  the  Propaga- 
tion of  the  Gospel  in  foreign  parts.  Work 
at  once  commenced,  and  it  consisted  of 
three  great  branches  (1)  the  care  and 
instruction  of  our  own  people  settled  in  the 
colonies ;  (2)  the  conversion  of  the  Indian 

2  z  2 


"MS 


SOCIETIES 


natives ;  (3)  the  conversion  of  the  negro 
slaves.  The  fii-st  missionaries,  the  Eevs. 
George  Keith  and  Patrick  Gordon,  sailed 
from  England  on  April  24, 1702,  and  landed 
at  Boston  on  June  11.  Since  that  time 
great  activity  has  been  displayed  on  the 
part  of  the  Society,  not  only  for  the 
spiritual  welfare  of  our  colonists,  hut  for 
spreading  the  gospel  among  the  heathen. 
On  April  6,  1882,  the  old  charter  having 
heen  found  insufficient  for  the  present 
wants.  Her  Majesty  was  graciously  pleased 
to  grant  a  supplemental  charter,  which  will 
simplify  the  Society's  operations,  and  by 
representation  will  give  to  all  its  members 
a  share  in  the  administration  of  its  affairs. 
It  is  asserted  by  some  that  the  S.P.G. 
simply  sends  missionaries  to  our  colonists 
without  regard  to  converting  the  heathen ; 
the  extent  and  character  of  the  work  as 
given  in  the  different  reports  from  mission- 
aries is  a  sufficient  answer  to  such  an 
error. 

III.  The  Chuech  Missionary  Society 
was  instituted  April  12,  1799.  Its  object  is 
to  promote  the  spread  of  the  gospel  among  the 
heathen ;  and  it  has  done  great  work  side 
by  side  with  the  elder  sister  Society.  The 
earliest  mission  of  this  Society  was  to  West 
Africa,  a  field  of  labour  naturally  chosen,  as 
WUberforce  and  others  of  the  founders  of 
the  C.M.S.  took  so  deep  an  interest  in 
suppressing  the  slave  trade,  and  raising 
the  liberated  slaves  from  their  misery  and 
darkness.  The  first  two  missionaries  went 
out  in  1804.  They  were  Germans,  the 
reason  assigned  why  Englishmen  had  not 
been  obtained  for  the  work  being  "  that  our 
countrymen  were  not  then  alive  to  their 
duty."  Considering  the  readiness  of  English- 
men for  any  foreign  enterprise,  this  seems 
extraordinary,  and  probably  there  were 
other  reasons.  At  all  events,  many  fol- 
lowed with  varying  success  tUl  1818,  when 
a  great  spiritual  uprousing  took  place  the 
effects  of  which  on  the  African  Church 
have  been  permanent.  The  Native  Church 
in  1862  was  recognised  on  an  independent 
basis,  and  undertook  the  support  of  its 
own  churches,  clergy,  &c.  The  Church 
Missionary  Society,  like  the  elder  sister 
Society,  sends  missionaries  to  all  parts  of 
the  world,  and  largely  sup|xirts  native 
clergy  and  teachers. — [Eeport,  1886  ;  Official 
Year-book,  1886,  p.  201.] 

IV.  The  National  Society  was  founded 
in  1811.  Its  main  object,  as  expressed  in  the 
words  of  the  charter,  is  to  secure  "  that  the 
poorer  members  of  the  Church  shall  have 
their  children  daily  instructed  in  suitable 
learning,  and  the  principles  of  the  Chris- 
tian religion  according  to  the  Established 
Church."  The  Society  has  endeavoured  to 
carry  out  this  object  in  two  chief  ways  (1^ 


SOCIETIES 

by  multiplying  the  number  of  properly  con- 
structed school  buildings ;  (2)  by  promoting 
the  most  approved  system  of  instruction  by 
the  establishment  of  training  institutions  for 
teachers :  also  by  supplying  at  a  reduced 
cost  lesson  books,  apparatus,  &c.,  and  bj' 
the  occasional  inspection  of  schools.  Since 
the  passing  of  the  Education  Act,  1870, 
followed  by  those  of  1873,  1876,  and  1880, 
the  Society  has  endeavoured  to  watch  and 
protect  the  interests  of  the  Church  under 
the  working  of  the  new  Acts,  and  to  maintain 
as  far  as  possible  the  distinctive  religious 
character  of  Chm-ch  schools.  Chiefly  by 
the  exertions  of  the  National  Society  the 
new  code  of  1882  was  considerably  modi- 
fied. 

V.  Church  Pastoral  Aid  Society  : 
founded  in  1836  for  the  evangelization  of  the 
home  population  by  means  of  the  parochial 
organization  of  the  Church  of  England. 
In  1885  the  grant  made  to  poor  parishes 
and  districts  amounted  to  761,  of  which 
609  are  for  the  clergy,  152  for  lay  agents. 

VI.  Society  for  Promoting  the  Employ- 
ment OF  Additional  Ccrates  :  founded  in 
1837,  principally  through  the  exertions  of 
the  Bishop  of  London  (Dr.  Blomfield),  Mr. 
Joshua  Watson,  and  Mr.  Benjamin  Harri- 
son. According  to  the  first  report  (1838), 
"  the  object  of  this  Society  is  to  increase  the 
means  of  pastoral  instruction,  and  super- 
intendence at  present  possessed  by  the 
Church ;  and,  in  order  thereto,  to  provide 
a  fund  for  contributing  to  the  maintenance 
of  additional  clergymen  in  those  parishes 
within  the  several  dioceses  of  England  and 
Wales  where  their  services  are  most 
required."  Many  missionaries  are  by  this 
Society  sent  to  labour  among  the  increasing 
masses  in  our  great  towns ;  717  additional 
clergy  are  by  its  means  supported;  and 
the  population  benefited  is  estimated  at 
6,000,000.     [H.] 

Vil.  Church  Defence  Institution  : 
founded  in  1859,  chiefly  by  the  exertions  of 
Mr.  Henry  Hoare.  Its  full  title  is  the 
"  Church  Institution,  an  Association  of 
Clergy  and  Laity  for  Defensive  and  General 
Purposes,"  and  the  following  were  the  first 
two  rules  adopted  by  its  promoters  : — 

1.  That  the  objects  of  the  Institution 
shall  be — to  combine,  as  far  as  possible. 
Churchmen  of  every  shade  of  political  and 
religious  opinion  in  the  maintenance  and 
support  of  the  Established  Church,  and  its 
rights  and  privileges  in  relation  to  the 
State, — particularly  as  regards  all  questions 
affecting  its  welfare  likely  to  become  the 
subject  of  legislative  action :  and  generally 
to  encourage  the  co-operation  of  clergy  and 
laity,  in  their  several  districts,  for  the  pro- 
motion of  measures  conducive  to  the  welfare 
of  the  Church. 


SOCIETIES 

2.  That  no  question  touching  Doctrine 
shall  be  entertained  at  any  meeting. 

In  1871,  after  the  disestablishment  of 
the  Irish  Church,  the  Institution,  which 
had  hitherto  been  exclusively  under  lay 
management,  was  reconstituted  as  "the 
Church  Defence  Institution,"  the  Arch- 
bishop of  Canterbury  accepted  the  office  of 
president,  and  the  Archbishop  of  York  with 
nearly  all  the  bishops  joined  the  society 
as  vice-presidents.  At  the  same  time  the 
Rev.  Dr.  Alfred  T.  Lee  was  appointed 
secretary,  and  from  that  time  until  his 
death  in  1883  contributed  very  largely  to 
the  development  and  progress  of  the  In- 
stitution. While  the  work  of  the  com- 
mittee has  been  mainly  directed  to  the 
defence  of  the  Church  against  assailants 
from  without,  against  those,  that  is,  who 
would  deprive  her,  and  through  her,  the 
country,  of  the  position,  endowments,  and 
buildings  which  she  holds  for  the  service  of 
Almighty  God,  every  assistance  has  been 
given  to  movements  which  have  had  for 
their  object  the  strengthening  and  increased 
efficiency  of  the  Church.  Among  such  may 
be  specially  mentioned  the  increase  of  the 
Episcopate.  The  Institution  publishes  a 
monthly  paper,  The  National  Church,  and 
issues  a  large  number  of  pamphlets  and 
leaflets  on  the  Church  and  State  question 
for  widespread  distribution.  The  income 
of  the  Institution  for  the  year  1884  was 
£4,570  14s.  Zd.    [H.  G.  D.] 

There  are  many  other  societies,  of  a  few 
of  which  only  mention  can  be  made,  as— 

VIII.  Society  for  Promoting  Christianity 
among  the  Jews :  fouuded  1809. 

IX.  Incorporated  Church  Building 
Society:  founded  1818,  incorporated  by 
Eoyal  Charter,  July  1826. 

X.  Colonial  and  Continental  Society : 
sprung  from  the  Newfoundland  School 
Society  (1823),  and  the  Colonial  Church 
Society  (1835),  which  were  amalgamated 
(1851) ;  and  took  present  name  1861.  Its 
work  is  carried  on  in  28  colonial  dioceses. 

XL  Church  Sunday  School  Institute 
(1843). 

XII.  Church  Scripture  Eeaders  Associa- 
tion (1844). 

XIII.  Church  of  England  Temperance 
Society. 

XIV.  Curates'  Augmentation  Fund. 

XV.  Church  Penitentiary  Association. 

XVI.  Missions  to  Seamen. 

Besides  these  few  mentioned,  there  are 
a  great  number  of  Institutions,  Funds, 
Missions,  Charitable  Associations,  &c., 
many  springing  from  the  above,  connected 
with  the  Church  of  England.  The  Religious 
Tract  Society  is  conducted  by  a  committee 
composed  of  an  equal  number  of  Churchmen 
and  Nonconformists,   and  so  is  the  Bible 


SOFFIT 


70» 


Society- — a  very  large  one.  A  list  of  societies 
is  given  in  the  Church  of  England  Official 
Year-book  of  1886,  and  fuller  accounts  of 
the  history  of  some  of  them  in  that  of 
1883.  Each  society  also  publishes  an 
annual  report.     [H.] 

SOCINIANS  (See  Unitariam).  A  sect 
of  heretics,  so  called  from  their  founder, 
Faustus  Socinus,  a  native  of  Siena  in  Italy, 
born  in  1539.     Their  tenets  are — 

1.  That  the  eternal  Father  was  the  one 
only  God;  that  the  Word  was  no  more 
than  an  expression  of  the  Godhead,  and  had 
not  existed  from  all  eternity;  and  that 
Jesus  Christ  was  God,  no  otherwise  than  by 
His  superiority  above  all  creatures,  who 
were  put  in  subjection  to  Him  by  the 
Father. 

2.  That  Jesus  Christ  was  not  a  me- 
diator between  God  and  men,  but  sent  into 
the  world  to  serve  as  a  pattern  of  their  con- 
duct :  and  that  He  ascended  up  to  heaven 
only,  as  it  were,  to  take  a  journey  thither. 

3.  That  the  punishment  of  hell  will 
last  but  for  a  certain  time,  after  which  both 
body  and  soul  will  be  destroyed.     And, 

4.  That  it  is  not  lawful  for  priuces  to 
make  war.  But  many  Socinians  hold  the 
first  two  doctrines  alone. 

These  four  tenets  were  what  Socinus  de- 
fended with  the  greatest  zeal:  in  other 
matters,  he  was  a  Lutheran,  or  a  Calvinist. 
The  truth  is,  he  did  but  refine  upon  the 
errors  of  all  the  Anti-Trinitarians  who  had 
gone  before  him. 

The  Socinians  spread  extremely  iu  Po- 
land, Lithuania,  and  Transylvania.  Their 
chief  school  was  at  Bacow,  and  there  all 
their  first  books  were  puljlished.  Their 
sentiments  are  explained  at  large  in  their 
catechism,  printed  several  times,  under  the 
title  of  Catechesis  Ecclesiarum  Polonicarum 
unum  Deum  pair  em,  iUiusque  filium  uni- 
genitum,  uno  cum  Sancto  tSpiritu,  ex  sacra 
scriptura  confitentium.  They  were  exter- 
minated out  of  Poland  in  1655  ;  since  which 
time  they  have  been  chiefly  sheltered  in 
Holland;  where,  though  their  public  meet- 
ings have  been  prohibited,  they  find  means 
to  conceal  themselves  under  the  names  of 
Arminians  and  Anabaptists. — Stubbs'  Mos- 
heim,  iii.  pp.  460,  462,  532;  Bullingers 
Orig.  Letters  ;  Parker's  Soc.  ii.  p.  700. 

SOFFIT  (Fr.  soffits,  fromLat.  sub-facere). 
The  under-surface  of  an  arch.  In  the  no- 
menclature of  mouldings,  the  soffit-plane  is 
the  plane  at  right  angles  with  the  face  of 
the  wall,  which  is  the  direction  of  the  soffit 
in  its  simplest  form.  Courses  of  mouldings 
occupying  the  soffit-plane  and  the  wall- 
plane,  to  the  exclusion  of  the  chamfer-plane, 
indicate  Norman  or  Early  English  work.  In 
mathematics  it  is  called  the  intrados,  ami 
the  top  of  the  arch  the  extrados. 


710 


SOLEMN  LEAGUE 


SOLEMN  LEAGUE  AND  COVE- 
NANT (See  Covenanf). 

SOLPIDIANS  (Lat.  Sola  fides).  Those 
who  rest  on  faith  alone  for  salvation,  with- 
out any  connexion  with  works;  or  who 
judge  themselves  to  be  Christ's  because 
they  believe  they  are. — Bull,  Harm.  Apost. 
Diss.  Post.  xvii.  5. 

SOMPNOUR  (Chaticer).  A  summoner  ; 
an  officer  employed  to  summon  delinquents 
to  appear  in  ecclesiastical  courts;  now 
called  an  apparitor. 

SON  Ob"  GOD  (See  Jesus,  Lord). 
"  The  Son,  which  is  the  Word  of  the  Father, 
begotten  from  everlasting  of  the  Father,  the 
very  and  eternal  God,  and  of  one  substance 
with  the  Father,  took  man's  nature  in  the 
wombof  the  Blessed  Virgin,  of  her  substance : 
so  that  two  whole  and  perfect  natures,  that  is 
to  say,  the  Godhead  and  Manhood,  were 
joined  together  in  one  person,  never  to  be 
divided,  whereof  is  one  Christ,  very  God, 
and  very  Man;  Who  truly  suffered,  was 
crucified,  dead  and  buried,  to  reconcile  His 
Father  to  us,  and  to  be  a  sacrifice,  not  only 
for  original  guilt.but  also  for  all  actual  sins 
of  men." — Article  II.  He  is  the  trae,  proper, 
and  only  Son  of  God ;  begotten  "  from  the 
beginning ;  "  "  before  the  foundation  of  the 
world"  (1  St.  Pet.  i.  20;  1  St.  John  i.  1)  ; 
as  He  "  came  down  from  heaven  "  (St.  John 
vi.  38),  where  He  had  "  glory  with  the 
Father,"  "  before  the  world  was "  (St.  John 
xvii.  5)  ;  as  He  is  himself  called  God,  "  one  " 
with  the  "  Father"  (St.  John  x.  30),  being 
of  the  same  Divine  essence  communicated 
to  Him  (St.  Matt.  xi.  27  ;  St.  John  v.  26  : 
xiii.  3 :  xvi.  15 ;  Eom.  xiv.  9),  and  exer- 
cising a  power  above  that  of  all  created 
beings  (Eph.  i.  21 ;  Heb.  i.  2,  13 ;  1  St. 
Pet.  iii.  22).  By  Him  the  world  and  "  all 
things  were  made  "  (St.  John  i.  3, 10 ;  Col. 
i.  16;  Heb.  i.  2,  10),  "by  Whom  are  all 
things  "  (1  Cor.  viii.  6),  for  "  He  is  before 
all  things,  and  by  Him  all  things  consist " 
(Col.  i.  17).  "  All  things  are  put  in  subjec- 
tion under  His  feet,"  and  "nothing  is  left 
that  is  not  put  under  Him"  (Heb.  ii.  8; 
Pfi.  viii.  6 ;  1  Cor.  xv.  27  ;  Eph.  i.  22).  Of 
the  manner  and  nature  of  this  generation 
we  are  ignorant,  and  must  not  endeavour  to 
be  wise  above  what  is  written.  We  find 
our  Lord  declared  by  prophecy  to  be  a  "  Son 
begotten  "  (Ps.  ii.  7),  and  acknowledged,  by 
inspiration,  as  "the  only  begotten  Son" 
(St.  John  i.  14:  iii.  16;  1  St.  John  iv.  9). 
That  He  is  "  the  image  of  the  invisible  God, 
the  first-born  of  (or  before)  every  creature, 
for  by  Him  were  all  things  created  "  (Col.  i. 
15, 16) ;  and  Who  thus  "  being  in  the  form 
of  God,"  "  the  brightness  of  His  glory,  and 
the  express  image  of  His  person  "  (Heb.  i. 
3),  was  without  "  robbery  equal  to  God " 
(Phil.  ii.  6).      That  He  "  is  in  the  bosom 


SOETES 

of  the  Father '  (St.  John  i.  18),  and  is 
"  one  "  with  Him  (St.  John  x.  30).  Many 
similes  were  imagined  by  the  ancients  to 
elucidate  this :  as  the  sun  producing  light 
— a  fountain  its  streams,  &c.;  but  these  are 
all  mere  figures  of  speech,  and  no  real  ex- 
planations of  a  mystery  which  we  can  onlj' 
speak  of  in  the  words  revealed  to  us. 

He  was  foretold  in  Scripture  as  "  the  Son 
of  God  "  (St.  Luke  i.  35),  and  acknowledged 
on  earth — ^by  men  inspired  (St.  Matt.  xvi. 
16 ;  St.  John  i.  34 :  xx.  31 ;  Acts  ix.  20)  ;— 
by  devils  (St.  Matt.  viii.  29 ;  St.  Mark  iii.  11 ; 
St.  Luke  iv.  41) ; — and  by  the  world  (St. 
Matt.  xiv.  33  ;  St.  John  i.  49 :  xi.  27),  as  He 
shall  be  in  heaven  (Rev.  ii.  18).  There- 
fore He  addresses  God  as  His  "  Father  "  (St. 
Mark  xiv.  36,  &c.),  and  claims  to  Himself 
the  title  from  men  (St.  John  v.  18,  22- 
25  :  ix.  35  with  37,)  though  for  this  He  was 
accused,  by  the  Jews,  of  blasphemy  (St. 
John  X.  36 :  xix.  7). 

SONG  (Sax.  sing;  Ger.  sang).  As 
applied  to  sacred  subjects,  it  is  one  of  the 
classes  of  vocal  praise  mentioned  in  Scrip- 
ture: according  to  the  enumeration  of  the 
apostle  (Eph.  v.  19),  -^dKijio'is,  kol  vfivois, 
Koi  dSair  Trvfy/jLaTiKais  (Psalms,  and  hymns, 
and  spiritual  songs,  or  odes).  Wolfius,  in 
his  note  on  Eph.  v.  14,  quotes  an  opinion 
of  Heumannus,  in  his  Pcecile  (ii.  lib.  iii. 
frag.  390),  that  this  verse  of  the  apostle's, 
"  Awake,  thou  that  sleepest,  and  arise  from 
the  dead,  and  Christ  shall  give  thee  life,"  is  a 
fragment  of  an  ancient  Christian  hymn  or 
spiritual  song  :  and  remarks  that  there  is  a 
netural  rhythm  in  the  original : 

cyeipai  6  KadevdoiVj 

KoX  dvdara  in  tS>v  pcKpZv, 

KOL  €m(pavo'et  <roi  6  ^pitrros. 

Recent  discoveries  of  early  Christian 
hymns  in  the  Syriac  may  throw  light  on 
this  subject ;  and  here  Dr.  Burgess's  trans- 
lation of  the  hymns  of  Ephrem  Syrus 
may  be  consulted  with  advantage.  The 
Evening  Hymn  of  the  first  or  second  cen- 
tury, preserved  by  St.  Basil,  and  given  in 
Routh's  Reliquise  Sacrse,  is  an  interesting 
illustration  of  the  ancient  Christian  songs. 

The  word  song  in  the  old  Testament  is 
in  the  Hebrew  Shir  l^B*.  Many  of  the 
Psalms  are  so  denominated  (See  Smith's 
Diet.  Bible).  The  word  appears  by  com- 
parison of  different  passages  of  Seripture  to 
mean  anything  sung  to  instrumental  music, 
as  these  instruments  are  called  in  Scripture 
instruments  of  Shir,  i.e.  accompanying 
vocal  music.  See  2  Chron.  v.  13  (See 
Hyrrms).    [H.] 

SONGS  OF  DEGREES  (See  Degrees, 
and  Psalms). 

SORTBS.  A  method  of  divination 
borrowed  by  some  superstitious  Christians 


SOUTHCOTTIANS 

from  the  heathen,  and  condemned  by  several 
councils.  The  heathen,  opening  Homer,  or 
Virgil  at  hazard,  took  the  first  words  they 
found  as  indicating  future  events,  and  this 
they  called  Sortes  EomeriaB,  or  Sortes  Virgi- 
lianse.  The  imitators  of  this  custom  used 
the  Bible  in  the  same  way,  and  called  their 
divinations  Sortes  Biblicx  (See  Bath-KoL). 
SOUTHCOTTIANS.  The  deluded  fol- 
lowers of  one  Johanna  Southcot,  a  servant 
girl  at  Exeter,  who,  towards  the  close  of  the 
last  century,  gave  herself  out  as  the  woman 
in  the  wilderness,  mentioned  in  the  Apo- 
calypse, and  declared  that  she  held  converse 
■with  spirits,  good  and  bad,  and  with  the 
Holy  Ghost  himself.  She  gave  sealed  papers, 
which  were  called  her  "seals,"  to  her  fol- 
lowers, which  were  to  protect  them  from  all 
evil  of  this  life  and  the  next.  In  1814, 
having  fallen,  from  indulgence  and  want  of 
exercise,  into  a  habit  of  body  which  gave  her 
the  appearance  of  pregnancy,  she  announced 
herself  the  mother  of  the  approaching  Shiloh. 
The  influence  she  exercised  was  evidently 
great,  for  being  visited  by  Dr.  Eeece,  a  phy- 
sician of  some  eminence,  she  persuaded  him 
that  she  was  indeed  pregnant,  though  he  was 
convinced  she  was  a  virgin.  She  died,  how- 
ever, and  her  body  was  opened,  revealing  the 
real  cause  of  her  appearance ;  but  her  death 
and  bmial  did  not  undeceive  her  followers, 
though  no  resmrrection  of  their  leader  has 
yet  taken  place. — Reece's  Correct  Statement, 
1815. 

SPANDRIL.  The  triangular  portion  of 
wall  between  two  arches,  or  an  arch  and  the 
adjoining  wall ;  or  between  the  side  of  an 
arch  and  the  square  panel  in  which  it  is  set. 
The  latter  is  a  remarkable  feature  in  perpen- 
dicular doorways,  being  often  richly  orna- 
mented with  figures,  foliage,  or  heraldic 
shields. 

SPIEE  (Gk.  oTTelpa,  anything  wound, 
twisted ;  Lat.  spira).  A  body  that  shoots 
up  to  a  point.  In  architecture,  the  high 
pyramidal  capping  or  roof  of  a  tower.  The 
earliest  spires  still  existing  in  England  are 
Early  English ;  and  in  this  style,  as  well  as 
in  the  next,  or  Geometric,  it  is  generally  of 
the  form  called  a  broach.  In  the  Decorated, 
the  broach  and  the  parapeted  spire  occur 
indifferently ;  in  the  Perpendicular,  the  lat- 
ter almost  exclusively,  though  there  is  a 
large  portion  of  Leicestershire  and  North- 
amptonshire in  which  Perpendicular  broaches 
are  not  imcommon.  Many  of  our  loftiest 
spires  were  formerly  of  timber  covered  with 
lead :  such  was  the  spire  of  old  St.  Paul's 
cathedral,  the  highest  in  the  kingdom  (527 
feet) ;  such  is  still  the  remarkable  twisted 
spire  of  Chesterfield.  Several  smaller  spires 
of  this  kind  remain  in  the  southern  counties, 
but  the  perishableness  of  the  material  has  led 
to  the  destruction  of  by  far  the  greater  num- 


STALLS 


711 


ber  of  them.  The  spire  of  Salisbury  cathe- 
dral is  404  feet  high;  St.  Michael's,  Co- 
ventry, 320 ;  Norwich,  313 ;  Louth,  294 ; 
Chichester,  271.  There  are  loftier  spires  on 
the  Continent,  as  Cologne,  two  of  510  feet ; 
Strasburg,  463 ;  Hamburg,  485 ;  Vienna, 
440 ;  Eeims  and  Amiens,  422 ;  but  our 
proportions  are  on  the  whole  much  better 
(See  Church  Architecture).    [G.] 

SPLAY.  The  slanting  expansion  inwards 
of  windows,  for  the  wider  diffusion  of  light. 
This  usually  appears  very  great  in  Norman 
windows,  where  the  external  aperture  is 
SEoall;  but  the  general  rule  both  in  that 
and  others  is  about  45° :  never  more  open 
than  that,  but  sometimes  less. 

SPONSORS.  In  the  administration  of 
baptism,  these  have  from  time  immemorial 
held  a  distinguished  and  important  place. 
Various  titles  have  been  given  them  indi- 
cative of  the  position  they  hold,  and  the 
duties  to  which  they  are  pledged.  Thus 
they  are  called  sponsors,  because  in  infant 
baptism  they  respond  or  answer  for  the 
baptized.  They  are  sureties,  in  virtue  of 
the  security  given  through  them  to  the 
Church,  that  the  baptized  shall  be  "  vir- 
tuously brought  up  to  lead  a  godly  and  a 
Christian  life."  And  from  the  spiritual 
affinity  here  created,  by  which  a  responsi- 
biUty  almost  parental  is  undertaken  by  the 
sureties,  in  the  future  training  of  the  bap- 
tized, the  terms  godfather  and  godmother 
have  taken  their  rise  (See  Ood-parents). 

SQUINCH.  Also  absurdly  called  by 
persons  who  like  fine  words,  Pendentive; 
which  suggests  an  entirely  wrong  idea  of  it. 
It  is  clearly  related  to  squint,  and  means 
almost  any  diagonal  construction  across  a 
corner,  and  chiefly  a  small  arch  thro\vn 
across  the  angle  of  a  square  tower,  to  receive 
one  of  the  sides  of  an  octagonal  spire  or 
lantern.     [G.] 

SQUINT  (See  Hagioscope). 
STALLS.  In  a  cathedral  or  coUegiate 
church,  and  often  in  parish  churches,  cer- 
tain seats  constructed  for  the  clergy  and 
other  members  of  the  Church,  and  intended 
for  their  exclusive  use.  These  stalls  are 
placed  in  that  portion  of  the  building  called 
the  choir,  or  the  part  in  which  Divine 
service  is  usually  performed. 

In  ancient  times,  all  members  of  the 
cathedral,  including  lay  clerks  or  vicars, 
had  their  stalls :  though  the  inferior  mem- 
bers had  not  always  fixed  stalls  appropri- 
ated to  each  individual.  Unless  when  the 
community  was  very  small,  there  was  an 
upper  and  lower  range  of  stalls,  called  the 
prima  et  secunda  forma  (or  gradus),  the 
upper  appropriated  to  the  canons  or  pre- 
bendaries (and  sometimes  the  priest-vicars 
or  minor  canons),  the  lower  to  the  other 
members.      The    designation    of    the    re- 


712 


STANDING 


spectivo  dignitaries  and  canons  were  writ- 
ten on  their  stalls ;  in  some  few  instances, 
those  of  the  minor  canons  or  priest-vicars 
also.  They  generally  were  enclosed  at  the 
back,  and  had  highly  decorated  canopies 
over  them.  The  tinest  old  ones  remaining 
are  at  Winchester  and  Norwich.  At  Can- 
terbury, Prior  d'Estria's  fine  Decorated  stone 
screen,  now  glazed,  takes  the  place  of  the 
backs  and  canopies,  but  the  stalls  themselves 
are  destroyed.  In  many  cathedrals  they 
have  been  well  reproduced  after  destruc- 
tion. 

The  6ame  word  is  also  used  to  signify  the 
preferment,  which  gives  the  person  holding 
it  a  seat,  or  stall,  in  a  cathedral  or  collegiate 
church. 

STANDING.  The  posture,  from  the 
earliest  times,  at  the  reading  of  the  gospel, 
and  during  psalmody  (Aug.  Serm.  3,  in  Ps. 
sxxvi. ;  see  Oosjtel).  It  was  the  general 
custom  to  stand  in  prayer  on  the  Lord's 
day,  and  the  fifty  days  between  Easter  and 
Pentecost.  This  may  be  traced  as  far  back 
as  Irena;us,  who  derives  it  from  apostolical 
authority ;  Tertullian  and  St.  Cyprian  both 
speak  of  it,  as  also  do  later  writers,  such  as 
SS.  Hilary,  Jerome,  Augustine,  and  Chiy- 
sostom  (Bingham,  viii.  xiii.  3).  Sermons 
also  were  in  some  places  heard  standing,  as 
appears  from  many  passages  in  St.  Augus- 
tine. Occasionally  the  Holy  Eucharist  was 
received  standing,  and  indeed  this  has  been 
claimed  as  the  primitive  custom  ;  "  Stantes, 
non  ut  hodie  genibus  flexis,  accipiebant " 
(Vales,  in  he. ;  see  Bona,  Ber.  Liturg.  lib.  ii. 
17).  In  the  Church  of  England  the  rubrics 
generally  order,  or  custom  allows,  standing 
in  praise  and  song  ;  kneeling  in  prayer  and 
supplication ;  sitting  in  listening.  In 
American  churches  the  general  thanks- 
giving is  repeated  by  all  the  congregation 
standing.     [H."| 

STATE  PEAYEES.  This  name  is  given 
to  the  special  prayers  issued  by  the  Primate 
of  all  England  from  time  to  time  by  royal 
authority,  and  sometimes  without  it,  to  be 
used  in  churches  either  on  an  appointed 
feast  or  fast  or  for  some  considerable  time  ; 
and  also  fonnerly  on  January  30,  the  exe- 
cution of  Charles  I. ;  May  29,  the  restoration 
of  Charles  II.  and  his  escape  from  Cromwell's 
soldiers  in  the  oak ;  November  5,  Gun- 
powder Plot  and  the  arrival  of  AVilliam 
III.  and  the  Sovereign's  accession.  'J'hese 
were  under  no  Acts  of  Parliament,  but  a 
royal  order  for  them  was  issued  at  the  be- 
ginning of  every  reign.  In  1859  another 
order  discontinued  all  but  the  Accession 
service,  as  may  be  seen  in  Prayer  Books, 
and  an  Act  was  passed  repealing  the  previous 
Acts  for  observing  the  first  three  days  as 
holidays — quite  different  from  the  three 
modern  "  bank  holidays,"  under  an  Act  of 


STEPHEN'S,  ST.,  DAY 

very  questionable  benefit  to  working  people, 
as  they  generally  both  lose  and  spend  from 
one  to  three  days'  wages  at  each  of  them, 
and  many  are  forced  to  be  idle  who  would 
rather  not.  The  Accession  service  has  still 
no  statutable  force,  though  it  would  doubt- 
less be  held  lawful  under  the  common  law 
of  the  Church  established  by  long  usage. 
It  is  not  literally  covered  by  the  new  rubric 
of  1870,  which  gives  absolute  precedence  to 
the  services  of  the  four  great  Sunday  feasts, 
and  leaves  the  conflict  between  other  saints' 
days  with  proper  lessons  and  the  usual 
Sunday  ones  to  "  the  discretion  of  the 
mhiister."  The  ordinary  has  only  power  to 
allow  and  not  to  order  any  alteration  of  the 
regular  lessons  or  psalms.  There  can  be 
no  objection  to  reading  the  additional 
prayers  in  that  service,  like  any  ordinary 
"state  prayers,"  whenever  the  Accession 
day  occurs  on  Sunday  or  any  holyday.  [G.] 
STATIONS.  The  weekly  fasts  of  Wed- 
nesday and  Friday.  I.  Not  long  after 
Justin  Martyr's  time,  the  Church  observed 
the  custom  of  meeting  solemnly  for  Divine 
worship  on  Wednesdays  and  Fridays,  which 
days  are  commonly  called  the  stationary 
days,  because  they  continued  their  assem- 
blies on  those  days  to  a  great  length,  i.e.  till 
three  o'clock  in  the  afternoon :  for  which 
reason  they  had  also  the  name  of  semi- 
jejunia,  or  half  fasts,  in  opposition  to  the 
Lent  fasts,  which  were  always  held  till 
evening. — Bingham,  bk.  xiii.  ix.  2.  II. 
Stations,  in  the  Eomish  Church,  denote 
certain  churches  in  which  indulgences  are 
granted  on  certain  days.  The  ceremony  of 
the  clergy  going  out  of  the  choir  and  singing 
before  the  tomb  of  a  martyr,  or  some  "  sta- 
tion "  or  object  hallowed  in  their  minds,  has 
also  this  name.  III.  In  modem  times  the 
word  is  used  to  imply  devotions  in  front 
of  pictures  or  sculptures  representing  the 
leading  incidents  of  our  Lord's  Passion,  and 
placed  at  intervals  in  the  church,  and  some- 
times in  other  places.  These  were  greatly 
promoted  by  Benedict  XIV.  (fifteenth  cen- 
tury), and  are,  (1)  the  condemnation  of  our 
Lord ;  (2)  bearing  the  cross ;  (3)  falling 
under  the  cross ;  (4)  our  Lord  meeting  the 
Virgin ;  (5)  the  Cyrenian  beaiing  the  cross ; 

(6)  the  Veronica  wiping  our  Lord's  face  ; 

(7)  our  Lord  falling ;  (8)  consoles  the 
daughters  of  Jerusalem ;  (9)  falling  again ; 
(10)  stripped;  (11)  crucified;  (12)  dies; 
(13)  taken  down  from  the  cross ;  (14)  laid 
in  the  grave.  These  have  been  declared 
illegal  in  the  Church  of  England.     [H.] 

STEEPLE  (Sax.  stepel,  styijel).  The 
tower  of  a  church  with  all  its  appendages,  if 
any,  as  turret,  octagon,  and  spire.  It  is  olten 
incorrectly  confounded  with  the  spire. 

STEPHEN'S,  ST.,  DAY.  A  festival  of 
the  Christian  Church,  observed  on  the  2(jtk 


STIPENDIARIES 

of  December,  in  honour  of  tlie  proto-martyr, 
St.  Stephen. 

STIPENDIARIES.  Members  of  col- 
legiate choirs,  who  do  not  possess  an  inde- 
pendent estate,  but  are  paid  stipends. 

STOLE,  or  OEAEIUM  ((n-oX,,  i>pipiov). 
A  tippet  or  narrow  scarf.  The  Council  of 
Laodicea  has  two  canons  (22,  23)  concern- 
ing the  use  of  the  orarium,  which  might  be 
used  by  presbyters  and  deacons  but  not  by 
the  inferior  orders.  Other  councils  give 
ciirections  as  to  its  use  {Cone.  Brae.  i.  c. 
27  :  iii.  c.  3 ;  Tolet.  iv.  28,  &c.),  and  many 
writers  refer  to  it.  The  word  "  stole  "  did 
not  come  in  till  later.  The  oxoXtj  (lit.  an 
equipment)  meant  any  dress,  but  in  Latin 
(stola)  implied  in  the  first  instance  the 
dress  of  a  Roman  matron.  How  it  came  to 
mean  the  vestment  the  word  afterwards 
was  used  for,  is  a  matter  of  conjecture 
(Durand.  Rat.  Div.  Off.  iii.  5 ;  Maniott, 
Vest.  Christ,  p.  215).  It  came  to  be  a 
narrow  scarf  with  fringed  extremities,  that 
crossed  the  breast  to  the  girdle,  and  thence 
descended  in  front  on  both  sides  as  low  as 
the  knees.  The  deacon  wore  it  over  the 
left  shoulder,  and  in  the  Latin  Church 
joined  under  the  right  arm,  but  in  the 
Greek  Church  with  its  two  extremities,  one 
in  front  and  the  other  hanging  down  his 
back.  The  word  aytor  was  sometimes  thrice 
embroidered  on  it  instead  of  crosses.  It  is 
one  of  the  most  ancient  vestments  used 
by  the  Christian  clergy,  and  in  its  mystical 
signification  represented  the  yoke  of  Christ. 
Coloured  stoles  in  the  Church  of  England 
have  been  pronounced  by  the  Privy  Council 
to  be  illegal,  though  black  ones  have  not, 
being  supposed,  perhaps,  to  represent  the 
"  tippet  of  black  "  of  the  canons,  which  Bishop 
Grindal  spoke  of  as  stola  ah  utroque  humero 
pendvla  ad  talos  (See  Tippet ;  Vestments). 
— Bingham,  xiii.  viii.  2 ;  Palmer's  Ori</. 
Liturg.  ii.  316 ;  Diet.  Christ.  Antiq. ;  Robert- 
son on  the  Liturgy.     [H.] 

STOUP  (Sax.  Stoppa).  A  basm  to  re- 
ceive holy  water,  often  remaining  in  porches, 
or  in  some  other  place  near  the  entrance  of 
the  church,  and  towards  the  right  hand  of  a 
person  entering. 

SUBCHANTER  (See  Succentor). 

SUBDEACONS.  An  inferior  order  of 
clergy  in  the  early  Christian  Church,  so 
called  from  their  being  employed  in  sub- 
ordination to  the  deacons. 

The  first  notice  we  have  of  this  order  in 
any  writers,  is  about  the  middle  of  the 
third  century,  when  Cyprian  lived,  who 
speaks  of  subdeacons  as  settled  in  the 
Church  in  his  time.  The  author  of  the 
"  Constitutions "  refers  them  to  an  aposto- 
lical institution,  and  brings  in  St.  Thomas 
the  apostle,  giving  directions  to  bishops  for 
their  ordination.     But  in  this  he  is  singular, 


SUCGENTOK 


713 


it  being  the  general  opinion  that  subdeacons 
are  merely  of  ecclesiastical  institution. 

Their  ofSce  was  to  fit  and  prepare  the 
sacred  vessels  and  utensils  of  the  altar,  and 
deliver  them  to  the  deacons  in  the  time  of 
Divine  service ;  but  they  were  not  allowed 
to  minister  as  deacons  at  the  altar ;  not  even 
so  much  as  to  come  within  the  rails  of  it,  to 
set  a  paten  or  cup,  or  the  oblations  of  the 
people,  thereon.  Another  of  their  offices  was, 
to  attend  the  doors  of  the  church  during 
the  Communion  Service.  Besides  which 
ofRces  in  the  church,  they  had  another  out  of 
the  church,  which  was,  to  carry  the  bishop's 
letters  or  messages  to  foreign  Churches. 
Their  ordination  was  performed  without  im- 
position of  hands ;  and  the  ceremony  con- 
sisted in  their  receiving  an  empty  paten  and 
cup  from  the  hands  of  the  bishop,  and  an 
ewer  and  towel  from  the  archdeacon. 

The  office  of  subdeacon  does  not  subsist 
in  the  Church  of  England.  It  is,  however, 
mentioned  in  the  statutes  of  Henry  VIIl.'s 
foundations,  and  is  considered  to  be  identi- 
cal with  Epistoler.  The  four  subdeacons 
at  Hereford  are  lay  clerks. 

SUBDEAN.  An  officer  in  some  cathe- 
drals, who  assists  the  dean  in  maintaining 
the  discipline  of  the  Church.  In  some  cathe- 
drals of  the  old  foundation  he  is  a  permanent 
dignitary  and  canon  residentiary ;  in  others 
an  ordinary  canon  ;  at  York  a  mere  official, 
though  founded  in  1228;  in  others,  a  minor 
canon  or  vicar  choral,  and  then  his  jurisdic- 
tion was  merely  over  the  inferior  members 
(See  Vice  Dean). 

SUBINTRODUCT^  (See  Aoapetx). 

SUBLAPSARIANS.  Those' who  hold 
that  God  permitted  the  first  man  to  fall 
into  transgression  without  absolutely  pre- 
determining his  fall ;  or  that  the  decree  of 
predestination  regards  man  as  fallen,  by 
an  abuse  of  that  freedom  which  Adam  had,, 
into  a  state  in  which  all  were  to  be  left  to 
necessary  and  unavoidable  ruin,  who  were 
not  exempted  from  it  by  predestination 
(See  Supralapsarians). 

SUBSTANCE.  In  relation  to  the  God- 
head, that  which  forms  the  Divine  essence- 
or  being — that  in  which  the  Divine  attri- 
butes inhere.  In  the  language  of  the 
Church,  and  agreeably  with  holy  writ, 
Christ  is  said  to  be  of  the  same  substance- 
with  the  Father,  being  hegotten,  and  there- 
fore partaking  of  tlie  Divine  essence;  not 
made,  as  was  the  opinion  of  some  of  the 
early  heretics  (See  liomoousion.  Person, 
and  Trinity). 

SUCCENTOR.  The  precentor's  deputy 
in  cathedi'al  churches.  Sometimes  this 
officer  was  a  dignitary,  as  at  York  still,  and 
formerly  at  Glasgow,  Aberdeen,  Paris,  &c. ;. 
and  at  York  he  is  called  Succentor  Canoni- 
eorum,  to  distinguish   him  from  the  other 


714 


sucoEssioijr 


subohanter,  who  is  a  vicar  choral.  In  most 
churches  however  the  suhchanter  is  a  vicar 
or  minor  canon,  as  at  St.  Paul's,  Hereford, 
Lichfield,  St.  Patrick's,  Dublin,  &c. 

SUCCESSION,  APOSTOLICAL,  or 
UNINTERRUPTED.  The  doctrine,  or 
.rather  the  fact,  of  a  regular  and  continued 
transmission  of  ministerial  authority  in  the 
succession  of  bishops,  from  the  apostles  to  any 
■subsequent  period  (See  Apostolic  Succession). 

SUFFRAGANS.  The  word  properly 
signifies  all  the  provincial  bishops  who  are 
under  a  metropolitan,  and  they  are  called 
his  suffragans,  because  he  has  power  to  call 
them  to  his  provincial  synods  to  give  their 
suffrages  there. 

The  name  is  also  used  to  denote  a  class 
resembling  the  chorepiscopi,  or  country 
bishops,  of  the  ancient  Church  (See  Ohor- 
•episcopus') . 

In  the  very  beginning  of  the  Reforma- 
tion here,  an  Act  passed,  26  Henry  VIII. 
c.  14,  to  restore  this  order  of  men  under 
the  name  of  suffragan  liishops.  The  pre- 
amble recites,  that  good  laws  had  been 
made  for  electing  and  consecrating  arch- 
bishops and  bishops,  but  no  provision  was 
made  for  suffragans,  which  had  been  ac- 
customed here  for  the  more  speedy  ad- 
ministration of  the  sacraments,  and  other 
devout  things,  &c. ;  therefore  it  was  enacted 
that  the  places  following  should  be  the  sees 
of  bishops  suffragans  :  Bedford,  Berwick, 
Bridgewater,  Bristol,  Cambridge,  Colchester, 
Dover,  St.  Germain,  Guildford,  Gloucester, 
Grantham,  Huh,  Huntingdon,  Isle  of  Wight, 
Ipswich,  Leicester,  Marlborough,  Moulton, 
Nottingham,  Penrith,  Southampton,  Shafts- 
<bury,  Shrewsbuiy,  Taunton,  Thetford.  The 
bishop  of  each  diocese  shall  by  petition 
present  two  persons  to  the  king,  whereof  he 
shall  allow  one  to  be  the  suffragan,  and 
"thereupon  dh-ect  his  mandate  to  the  arch- 
bishop to  consecrate  him,  which  was  to  be 
■done  after  this  maimer :  first  it  recites  that 
the  bishop,  having  informed  the  king  that 
he  wanted  a  suffragan,  had  therefore  pre- 
sented two  persons  to  him  who  were  qualified 
for  that  office,  praying  that  the  king  would 
nominate  one  of  them ;  thereupon  he  nomi- 
nated P.  S.,  being  one  of  the  persons  pre- 
sented, to  be  suffragan  of  the  see  of  Ipswich, 
requiring  the  archbishop  to  consecrate  him. 
The  bishop  thus  consecrated  was  to  have  no 
greater  authority  than  what  was  limited  to 
him  by  commission  from  the  bishop  of  the 
-diocese,  and  was  to  last  no  longer.  This 
Act  was  repealed  by  1  &  2  Philip  &  Mary, 
■cap.  8;  but  revived  by  1  Elizabeth,  and 
■during  the  reign  of  that  sovereign  we  find 
notices  of  suffragans  at  Dover  and  else- 
where. Bishop  Gibson  mentions  Dr.  Stean, 
suffragan  of  Colchester  about  1606,  as  among 
the  last  of  these  suffragans. 


SUNDAY 

Suffragan  bishops  have  been  revived  of 
late.  There  are  now  suffragans,  named 
from  various  places  in  the  Act  of  Henry 
VIIL,  for  the  dioceses  of  Canterburj% 
London,  Lincoln,  and  St.  Alban's.  They 
have  no  powers  however,  except  such  as  are 
given  by  commission  from  and  during  the 
life  and  pleasure  of  the  diocesan.  And  it 
may  happen  that  a  new  and  able-bodied 
bishoiJ  may  have  no  use  for  the  suffragan 
who  was  appointed  and  commissioned  to 
assist  his  predecessor.  They  have  no 
salaries  as  such,  but  may  also  be  incum- 
bents, canons  or  archdeacons.  They  are 
quite  different  from  coadjutor  bishops,  who 
may  be,  but  never  have  been,  appointed 
under  the  Bishops'  Resignation  Act,  1869, 
and  who  have  the  right  to  succeed  the 
diocesan  who  t  has  not  resigned,  but  has 
been  duly  certified  to  be  incapacitated. 
Suffragans  have  no  such  right,  nor  have 
ever  in  fact  been  appointed  to  succeed  any 
diocesan.  The  only  effect  of  the  Act  is 
therefore  to  generate  bishops  who  may  be 
commissioned  as  above,  but  no  consent  of 
the  Crown  is  requisite  for  commissioning  ex- 
colonial  bishops  here  in  just  the  same  way, 
which  has  in  fact  been  done  several  times. 
A  bishop  cannot  lawfully  be  consecrated  in 
England  without  royal  authority.    [G.] 

SUFFRAGE.  A  vote,  token  of  assent 
and  approbation,  or,  as  in  public  worship, 
the  united  voice  and  consent  of  the  people 
in  the  petitions  offered. 

The  term  is  also  used  in  the  Prayer  Book 
to  designate  a  short  form  of  petition,  as  in 
the  Litany.  Thus,  in  the  Order  for  the 
Consecration  of  Bishops,  we  read  that  in  the 
Litany  as  then  used,  after  the  words, "  That 
it  may  please  thee  to  illuminate  all  bishops," 
&c.,  the  proper  suffrage  shall  be,  "  That  it 
may  please  thee  to  bless  this  our  brother 
elected,"  &c.'  The  versicles  immediately 
after  the  Creed,  in  Morning  and  Evening 
Prayer,  are  also  denominated  suffrages,  as  in 
the  instance  quoted  by  Johnson,  "  The 
suffrages  next  after  the  Creed  shall  stand 
thus.  Common  Prayer,  Form  of  Thanks- 
giving/or May  29  "  (See  Verside). 

The  Litany  in  "  the  Ordering  of  Deacons  " 
is  headed  the  Litany  and  Suffrages.  By 
suffrages  here  seems  to  be  meant  the  latter 
part  of  the  Litany,  called  the  supplication 
(See  Wheatly  in  loc.  and  Supplications'). 
In  some  old  choral  books  these  are  called 
the  second  suffrages. 

SUNDAY  (See  LorWs  Day).  The 
ancients  retained  the  name  Sunday,  or  Dies 
Solis,  in  compliance  with  the  ordinary  forms 
of  speech  ;  the  first  day  of  the  week  being 
so  called  by  the  Romans,  because  it  was 
dedicated  to  the  worship  of  the  sun.  Thus 
Justin  Martyr,  describing  the  worship  of 
the  Christians,  sj^eaks  of  the  day  which  is 


SUPER- ALTAE 

■called  that  of  the  sun  (Apol.  i.  G7).  Ter- 
tuUian  also  uses  a  similar  term  (Apol.  xvi., 
ad  Nation,  i.  13). 

Besides  the  most  solemn  parts  of  Christian 
worship,  which  were  always  performed  on 
Sundays,  this  day  was  distinguished  by  a 
pecuhar  reverence  and  respect  expressed  to- 
wards it  in  the  observation  of  some  special 
laws  and  customs.  The  imperial  (Christian) 
laws  forbad  all  proceedings  at  law  on  this 
day,  excepting  such  as  were  absolutely  ne- 
cessary ;  all  secular  and  servile  employments 
also  were  superseded  on  this  day,  though 
Constantine  allowed  works  of  husliandry,  as 
earing  and  harvest,  to  be  done  on  Sundays. 
Sports  or  games  of  the  lower  sort  might  not 
be  followed  on  this  day.  There  are  two 
famous  laws  of  the  two  Emperors  Theodosius 
to  this  purpose,  forbidding  the  exercises 
of  gladiators,  stage-plays,  and  horse-races  in 
the  circus,  to  be  exhibited  to  the  Christians. 
And  by  the  ecclesiastical  laws  diversions 
of  this  kind  were  universally  forbidden  to 
all  Christians,  on  account  of  the  extrava- 
gances and  blasphemies  that  were  committed 
in  them.  But  all  such  recreations  and  re- 
freshments as  tended  to  preservation  or  con- 
veniency  of  the  life  of  man  were  allowed  on 
the  Lord's  day.  And  therefore  Sunday 
was  always  a  day  of  feasting,  and  it  was 
never  allowable  to  fast  thereon,  not  even  in 
Lent. 

In  the  Eoman  Breviary  and  other  offices, 
we  meet  with  a  distinction  of  Sundays  into 
those  of  the  first  and  second  class.  Sundays 
of  the  first  class  are,  Palm  Sunday,  Easter 
Day,  Advent,  Whitsunday,  &c.  Those  of 
the  second  class  are  the  common  Simdays 
of  the  year. — Bingham,  xx.  ii.  2.  In  like 
manner,  by  the  Lectionary  Act  of  1870, 
Advent,  Easter,  Trinity,  and  Whitsunday 
are  always  to  prevail  over  accidental  holy- 
days  concurring  therewith.  For  a  complete 
history  of  Sunday,  and  discussion  of  all  the 
questions  connected  with  the  observance  of 
it,  see  Archdeacon  Hessey's  Bampton  Lec- 
tures, 1860.     [H.] 

SUPEE-ALTAR.  L  A  small  portable 
slab,  generally  of  costly  material,  formerly 
used  at  certain  times  to  consecrate  upon, 
being  laid  upon  the  mensa,  or  slab  of  stone 
or  wood  forming  the  top  of  the  Lord's  Table 
(See  Mensa)..  It  was  probably  in  the  first 
place  used  when  the  altar  itself  was  in  a  bad 
condition,  and  was  taken  about,  as  it  was 
also  called  Altare  viaticum,  Altare  portahile, 
and  Altare  itinerarium.  It  is  the  super- 
table  of  Cranmer. 

II.  It  has  been  of  late  years  taken  to 
mean  a  kind  of  step  or  shelf  at  the  back 
of  a  Communion  Table ;  which  has  been 
decided  to  be  illegal,  whether  actually  upon 
or  very  near  the  table.     [H.] 

SUPEK-FEONTAL.    L  Originally  a  de- 


SUPEEEEOGATION 


715 


coration  attached  to  the  wall  behind  and 
above  the  altar. 

II.  It  now  is  taken  to  mean  the  decora- 
tive hanging  which  overlaps  the  frontal, 
hanging  over  it  for  about  six  or  eight  inches. 

SUPEEBROGATION.  The  doctrine  of 
Supererogation  was  a  perversion  of  that  of 
the  communion  of  saints.  It  is  this : — The 
many  members  of  one  body  being  joined 
together  in  one  communion  and  fellow- 
ship, have  sympathy  in  each  other's  joys 
and  sorrows,  and  the  merit  of  good  works 
done  by  one  member  belongs,  nut  to  him, 
but  to  the  whole  body.  A  certain  amount 
of  good  works  must  be  ofiered  up  by  the 
Church  before  the  Lord's  second  coming, 
and  the  deficiencies  of  one  may  be  made  up 
by  the  good  works  of  another.  It  is  easy  to 
see  how  this  could  be  adopted  as  a  means  of 
gaining  power  and  authority.  Q'he  many 
saints  who  had  been  holy  and  blameless  in 
their  lives,  who  had  given  up  all  for  their 
Lord,  had  fought  and  died  for  the  Faith, 
have  done  more  than  was  required  for 
their  own  salvation.  These  constitute  an 
inexhaustible  fund,  on  which  the  Pope  has 
the  power  of  drawing  at  pleasure,  for  the 
relief  of  the  Church,  by  the  application  of 
some  portion  of  this  superabundant  merit, 
to  meet  a  deficiency  in  the  spiritual  worth 
of  any  of  its  members.  It  was  from  this 
that  the  idea  of  "  indulgences "  was  taken, 
which  was  the  kindling  spark  to  the  Eefor- 
mation. 

On  this  doctrine  of  the  Church  of  Eome 
our  Church  thus  speaks  in  the  fourteenth 
Article: — "Voluntary  works  besides,  over 
and  above  God's  commandments,  which 
they  call  works  of  supererogation,  cannot  be 
taught  without  arrogancy  and  impiety ;  for 
by  them  men  do  declare  that  they  do  not 
only  render  unto  God  as  much  as  they  are 
bound  to  do,  but  that  they  do  more  for  His 
sake  than  of  bounden  duty  is  required ; 
whereas  Christ  saith  plainly,  '  When  ye 
have  done  all  that  are  commanded  to  you, 
say.  We  are  unprofitable  servants.'  " 

The  works  here  mentioned  are  called  in 
the  Eomish  Church  like^vise  by  the  name 
of  "  counsels,"  and  "  evangelical  perfections." 
They  are  defined  by  their  writers  to  be 
"  good  works,  not  commanded  by  Christ, 
but  recommended ; "  rules  which  do  not 
oblige  all  men  to  follow  them,  under  the 
pain  of  sin;  but  yet  are  useful  to  carry  them 
on  to  a  sublimer  degree  of  perfection  than  is 
necessary  in  order  to  their  salvation.  But 
there  are  no  such  counsels  of  perfection  in 
the  gospel,  and  the  whole  theory  is  subver- 
sive of  that  humility  which  is  the  sign  of  a 
true  Christian,  and  leads  him  as  a  sinner  to 
Christ,  confessing  his  sins,  not  as  a  saint 
boasting  his  goodness. — Beveridge  on  Tliirty- 
ninth  Art. ;  Bishop  Harold  Browne,  ibid. 


71G 


SUPPLICATIONS 


SUPPLICATIONS  (Lat.  supplicalio ; 
suh  a,ni  pUco).  A  humble  entreaty.  Thus 
used  in  the  prayer  of  St.  Chrysostom,  "  our 
common  supplications." 

In  the  Litany  the  petitions  or  supplica- 
tions begin  with  the  words,  "  We  sinners  do 
beseech  Thee  to  hear  us  "  (Blunt's  Annot. 
P.  B.  i.  53),  but  properly  perhaps  the  suppli- 
cations are  the  two  offered  just  before  the 
versicles  and  prayers,  33  and  34,  one  for 
material  blessings,  and  the  other  for  spiritual 
(E.  Daniel's  P.  B.  163).  According  to 
Wheatly,  however,  the  part  followng  the 
Lord's  Prayer  is  called  the  Supplications, 
"which  were  first  collected  and  put  into 
this  form,  when  the  barbarous  nations  first 
began  to  overi'un  the  empire  about  six 
hundred  years  after  Christ ;  but,  considering 
the  troubles  of  the  Church  militant,  and  the 
many  enemies  it  always  hath  in  this  world, 
this  part  of  the  Litany  is  no  less  suitable 
than  the  foruaer  at  all  times  whatsoever." — 
Wheatly  (See  Litany  and  Suffrage).  In 
many  choirs,  and  at  the  universities,  this 
latter  part  of  the  Litany  is  performed  by  a 
different  minister  from  the  former:  in  ap- 
parent compliance  with  the  rubric,  which 
before  the  Lord's  Prayer  directs  that  the 
Priest  shall  say  it.  And  when  the  Litany 
is  sung  to  the  organ,  it  is  often  the  custom 
to  sing  the  responses  in  the  supplications 
without  that  accompaniment.     [H.] 

SUPEALAPSAHIANS.  A  sect  of  Cal- 
vinists.  The  way  in  which  they  under- 
stood the  Divine  decrees  has  produced  two 
distinctions  of  Calvinists,  viz.  Sublapsarians 
and  Supralapsarians.  The  former  term  is 
derived  from  two  Latin  words,  sub,  below  or 
after,  and  lapsus,  the  fall;  and  the  latter 
from  supra,  above,  and  lapsus.  The  Sub- 
lapsarians assert  that  God  had  only  per- 
mitted the  first  man  to  faU  into  trans- 
gression, without  absolutely  predetermining 
his  fall ;  their  system  of  decrees  concerning 
election  and  reprobation  being,  as  it  were, 
subsequent  to  that  event.  On  the  other 
hand,  the  Supralapsarians  maintained  that 
Grod  had,  from  all  eternity,  decreed  the 
transgression  of  man.  The  Supralapsarian 
and  Sublapsarian  schemes  agree  in  asserting 
the  doctrine  of  predestination,  but  with  this 
difierence — that  the  former  supposes  that 
God  intended  to  glorify  His  justice  in  the 
condemnation  of  some,  as  well  as  His  mercy 
in  the  salvation  of  others ;  and  for  that 
purpose  decreed  that  Adam  should  neces- 
sarily fall,  and  by  that  fall  bring  himself 
and  all  his  offspring  into  a  state  of  ever- 
lasting condemnation.  The  latter  scheme 
supposes  that  the  decree  of  predestination 
regards  man  as  fallen  by  an  abuse  of  that 
freedom  which  Adam  had,  into  a  state  in 
which  all  were  to  be  left  to  necessary  and 
unavoidable  ruin,  who  were  not  exempted 


SUPREMACY 

from  it  by  predestination. — Stubbs'  Mos- 
heim,  iii.  354. 

SUPEBMACY  OP  THE  CROWN  means, 
and  always  has  meant,  the  ultimate  juris- 
diction or  coercive  iMwer  (without  which. 
Sir  Matthew  Hale  said,  jurisdiction  has  no 
meaning)  of  the  Crown  or  the  State  in 
Parliament  and  the  courts  of  law,  whether 
the  king's  temporal  law  or  "  the  king's 
ecclesiastical  law,"  over  the  clergy.  The 
king  or  the  State  has  at  one  time  or  another 
given  to  the  ecclesiastical  courts,  and  in 
some  cases  to  the  bishops  personally,  what- 
ever coercive  power  they  have,  or  ever  had 
legally.  In  old  times  the  royal  supremacy 
had  chiefly  to  be  asserted,  and  was  asserted 
by  continual  Acts  of  Parliament,  against 
the  Pope  as  a  continual  aggressor,  and 
occasionally  against  bishops  and  convoca- 
tions ;  but  as  they  were  practically  subject 
to  the  Pope  until  the  Reformation,  and  his 
struggle  for  supremacy  either  lasted  or  was 
feared  till  long  afterwards — in  fact,  so  lone; 
as  there  was  a  Popish  pretender  to  the 
crown,  the  oaths  of  supremacy  were  main- 
tained in  the  original  form  of  denying  that 
any  foreign  prince  or  potentate  has  any 
authority  here,  which  has  now  been  dropped, 
and  a  simple  oath  of  allegiance  established, 
of  which  the  final  form,  for  the  present,  is 
that  given  by  the  Promissory  Oaths  Act, 
1868,  altering  the  Clerical  Subscription  Act, 
1865 :  "  I  do  swear  that  I  will  be  faithful 
and  bear  true  allegiance  to  Her  Majesty 
Queen  Victoria,  her  heirs  and  successors 
according  to  law,  so  help  me  God."  There 
are  slightly  varied  forms  for  the  "judicial 
and  official  oaths,"  and  all  others  are  abol- 
ished, and  nobody  is  required  to  take  any 
except  under  the  Clerical  Subscription  Act 
and  this  Act.  It  is  not  worth  while  to  go 
through  the  various  forms  prescribed  from 
time  to  time  previously. 

Another  fact  is  that  the  Church  of  England 
has  never  had  any  means  of  speaking  or 
legislating  for  itself  as  a  whole  except 
through  Parliament,  simply  because  it  was 
never  considered  as  anything  but  the  whole 
nation.  For  a  long  time  persons  who 
dissented  from  the  national  religious  doc- 
trines were  not  "  tolerated,"  as  the  saying 
is ;  and  for  long  after  they  were  tolerated, 
the  national  religion  of  the  State  was  not 
affected  thereby,  especially  as  they  were 
excluded  from  Parliament  by  tests.  There- 
fore when  it  is  called  an  anomaly  or  an 
usurpation  that  the  State  should  legislate 
for  the  Church,  it  has  only  become  so  since 
the  legislature  has  ceased  to  be  identical 
with  the  Church.  Clergymen  were  only 
legislated  out  of  the  House  of  Commons  in 
1780,  and  the  bishops  have  always  been 
an  estate  of  the  realm,  as  "the  Lords 
Spiritual."    And  as  we  are  now  considerino- 


SUPREMACY 

the  matter  historically,  it  is  not  so  much 
the  case  that  the  State,  which  can  only 
speak  through  Parliament,  was  supreme 
over  the  Church,  as  that  it  was  the  Church 
in  Parliament,  which  was  the  only  legis- 
lature that  the  Church  as  a  whole  ever  had. 
The  two  convocations  never  were  its  legis- 
lature. Indeed,  the  fact  that  they  are  not 
national  bodies,  but  provincial,  would  be 
decisive  on  that,  if  it  had  not  been  decided 
over  and  over  again  that  they  have  no 
jurisdiction  except  over  the  clergy,  so  far  as 
the  whole  Church,  i.e.  the  State,  has  from 
time  to  time  allowed,  and  from  time  to  time 
enacted,  overruling  a  multitude  of  canons. 

Undoubtedly  it  is  a  great  anomaly — but 
much  easier  to  confess  than  to  cure — that 
the  only  effective  legislature  of  the  Church 
of  England  may  now  comprise  any  number 
of  persons  who  are  hostile  to  it ;  but  that 
has  nothing  to  do  with  the  legal  history 
of  the  Supremacy,  and  it  certainly  never 
will  be  cured  by  constituting  the  clergy 
the  legislature  of  the  Church,  or  giving 
them  any  supremacy  therein.  Returning 
to  the  history  of  it,  which  has  been  much 
discussed  of  late,  especially  in  and  in 
connexion  with  the  report  of  the  Commis- 
sion on  Ecclesiastical  Courts  in  1883,  we 
are  not  aware  that  the  separate  report  of 
Lord  Penzance,  the  Dean  of  Arches,  on  the 
legal  history  of  the  Supremacy  has  been 
questioned  or  contradicted  by  the  much 
more  proli.x  one  of  two  non-legal  members 
of  the  Commission.  Without  quoting  the 
whole  of  Lord  Penzance's  history,  it  is  in 
substance  this :  "  Until  the  Conquest,  what- 
ever ecclesiastical  jurisdiction  was  exercised 
through  the  medium  of  a  court  as  distinct 
from  the  personal  power  and  control  of  the 
bishops,  was  exercised  in  the  temporal 
courts  of  the  country,  the  bishop  sitting  by 
the  side  of  the  temporal  judges  "  (which  has 
also  been  kept  up  in  every  one  of  the  four 
Acts  of  Uniformity,  though  practically  dis- 
used). "  This  is  stated  by  all  historians  of 
repute.  The  existing  ecclesiastical  courts 
first  existed  by  and  under  a  charter  of 
William  the  Conqueror,  which  professes  to 
be  n  ade  communi  concilia  of  the  bishops  and 
abbots  et  omnium  prindpum  regni  mei  . .  . 
It  was  the  king  therefore  who  created,  as  the 
charter  says,  regni  auctm-itate,  a  separate 
set  of  tribunals  for  the  treatment  of  ecclesi- 
astical law  and  the  practical  exercise  of 
purely  spiritual  jurisdiction  ...  It  appears 
to  me  that  what  the  sovereign,  with  the 
advice  of  his  council  in  Parliament,  set  up 
and  created,  the  sovereign,  with  the  advice 
of  Parhament,  may  alter  and  amend.  And 
as  a  matter  of  fact  and  history,  the  sove- 
reign, with  the  advice  of  Parfiament,  has 
never  hesitated  to  do  so  .  .  .  and  by  that 
authority  alone." 


SUPREMACY 


71 


Not  a  single  instance  could  be  found  b; 
that  Commission,  or  its  witnesses,  of  an; 
convocation  or  other  clerical  body  bein 
consulted  or  allowed  to  interfere  in  an 
legislation  about  ecclesiastical  courts,  thoug 
they  generally  were  about  the  Prayer  Bool 
and  Articles  (See  Okrgy). 

"  There  is  no  doubt  that  before  the  Con 
quest  the  bishops  did  exercise  authorit; 
and  control  over  both  clergy  and  laity  ;  bu 
that  was  a  judicial  authority  inherent  i: 
the  person  of  the  bishop  rather  than  th 
court,  and  might  be  exercised  in  synod,  i: 
visitation,  in  camera  or  in  itinere.  But  th 
erection  of  constituted  courts  with  a  coer 
cive  jurisdiction,  to  be  enforced  if  need  b 
by  the  civil  power,  was  a  different  mattei 
It  could  only  be  done  regid  auctoritat 
with  the  advice  of  Parliament.  The  olde 
law  books  are  not  silent  on  this  subject ; 
and  then  he  quotes  several  of  the  highes 
authority  to  the  same  effect  as  his  owi 
statements ;  and  proceeds,  "  I  come  there 
fore  to  the  conclusion  that  there  is  c 
warrant  to  be  found  in  the  history  of  thi 
country  for  the  proposition  that  there  hav 
existed  at  any  time  since  the  Conquest,  o 
indeed  before  it,  spiritual  courts  derivinj 
their  original  authority  from  the  Churcl 
independent  of  the  sovereign  or  the  state." 

All  this  has  since  received  a  remarkabl 
confirmation  and  extension  from  a  MS 
treatise  of  Sir  Matthew  Hale't-  in  Lincoln' 
Inn  Library,  which  was  published  in  thi 
Record  of  28th  November,  1884.  It  i 
much  too  long  to  copy  here,  and  difficult  ti 
do  justice  to  by  short  extracts.  Probabb 
no  civil  judge  has  ever  combined  such  ! 
knowledge  of  law  and  divinity  or  ecclesio 
logy  as  that  great  Lord  Chief  Justice  ;  an( 
his  treatise  is  enriched  with  a  multitudi 
of  references,  showing  that  he  was  no 
writing  mere  opinions  or  recollections  of  hii 
own.  We  must  be  content  with  oivinj 
these  principal  conclusions,  adding  only  oni 
other : — 

"  That  the  true  foundation  of  most  i 
not  all  the  power  ecclesiastical  was  in  th( 
civil  magistrate. 

"  The  consequence  is  that  an  Act  o 
Parliament  may  take  away  from  the  clergy 
or  abridge  or  alter  that  jurisdiction  ecclesi- 
astical (which  he  said  they  had  gradually 
usurped)  and  re-annex  it  to  the  Crown 
because  it  was,  even  in  its  greatest  height 
only  a  subordinate  derivative  power."  H( 
then  points  out  the  effect  of  some  of  the 
Reformation  Bt<itutes,  about  which  there 
can  be  no  doubt,  but  the  treatise  ends 
abruptly. 

The  Act  1  Eliz.  c.  1,  again  restored  the 
royal  supremacy  after  Mary,  and  establishec 
the  oath  of  supremacy  acknowledging  "  the 
Queen  (s.  9)  as  supreme  governor  of  this 


718 


SUPEEMACY 


realm  and  all  her  dominions  as  well  in  all 
spiritual  or  ecclesiastical  things  or  causes 
as  temporal,  and  that  no  foreign  prince  or 
potentate  shall  use,  enjoy  or  exercise  any 
jurisdiction,"  &c.  It  also  authorised  her  to 
create  the  High  Commission  Court  for 
ecclesiastical  causes  with  coercive  jurisdic- 
tion in  itself,  i.e.  without  "  signifying  con- 
tempts to  the  Queen  in  Chancery ; "  which 
was  aboHshed  by  16  Car.  I.  c.  11,  and  il- 
legally set  up  again  by  James  11.  and  de- 
clared illegal  by  1  W.  &  M.  sess.  2,  cap.  2. 

In  like  manner  the  37th  Article,  which 
every  incumbent  has  to  read  openly  and 
declare  his  assent  to,  and  all  clergy- 
men are  bound  by,  says  that  "  the  Queen's 
majesty  hath  the  chief  power  in  this 
realm  of  England  and  other  her  domi- 
nions; unto  whom  the  chief  government 
of  all  estates  of  this  realm  whether  ec- 
clesiastical or  civil  in  all  causes  doth 
appertain  .  .  .  but  that  prerogative  which  we 
see  to  have  been  given  to  all  godly  princes 
in  the  Holy  Scriptures  by  God  himself  is 
that  they  should  rale  all  estates  and  degrees 
committed  to  their  charge  by  Grod  whether 
ecclesiastical  or  temporal,  and  restrain  with 
the  civil  sword  the  stubborn  and  evil  doers." 
The  3rd  and  26th  canons  are  to  the  same 
effect.  The  clergy  do  not  promise  obedience 
to  the  canons  as  they  do  to  the  articles. 
Yet  it  is  material  to  notice  the  assent  of  the 
Convocations  by  canon  3  to  the  proposition 
that  jurisdiction  in  ecclesiastical  causes  had 
been  "  restored  to  the  Crown "  by  the  Re- 
formation statutes,  and  specially  the  one 
which  made  the  supreme  court  to  consist  of 
delegates  appointed  by  the  Crown  from  time 
to  time  (See  Delegates). 

The  only  attempt  that  was  ever  openly 
made  by  the  clergy  to  deny  or  qualify  the 
royal  supremacy  over  them  was  the  tempo- 
rarj'  and  short-lived  one,  just  a  year  before 
their  celebrated  submission,  viz.  in  May  1531, 
when  in  granting  money  to  Henry  VIII. 
they  called  him  ecclesise  et  cleri  Anglicani 
supremum  dominum,  et,  quantum  per  Christi 
legem  licet,  etiam  supremum  caput;  on 
which  it  must  be  observed,  1.  that  the 
qualification,  whatever  it  was  worth,  was 
only  of  the  word  "  caput "  and  not  of 
w  dominus  ecdesix  et  cleri,^'  which  are  very 
different  things;  2.  that  it  was  of  no  con- 
sequence to  the  king  whether  such  a 
qualification  was  introduced  or  not  in  a  mere 
grant  of  money ;  3.  that  nothing  of  the 
kind  appears  in  the  really  important 
document,  the  Submission  of  the^  clergy 
by  the  two  convocations  in  May  1532, 
by  which  they  promised  in  verho  sacerdotii 
to  make  no  move  canons  without  royal 
authority  and  assent,  and  agreed  that  all  the 
existing  ones  should  be  revised  by  a  royal 
commission  of  which    half   the    members 


SUPEEMACY 

were  to  be  laymen ;  which  they  did  to  avoid 
the  pr^munire  with  which  they  were 
threatened  for  having  done  so  before;  4.. 
that  the  Act  of  Parliament,  called  the  Act  of 
Submission,  of  the  following  year,  recited 
that  the  king  was  the  supreme  head  of  the 
Church  of  England,  and  so  is  recognised  by 
the  clergy  in  their  convocations,  as  he  had 
been.  Even  if  the  above  qualification  had. 
been  allowed,  it  had  nothing  to  do  with  the 
jurisdiction  of  any  court,  as  the  unqualified 
"  dominus  ecclesiie  et  cleri  "  had  ;  5.  the  Act 
contained  other  clauses  besides  those  about 
the  canons,  viz.  those  establishing  the- 
delegates  for  ecclesiastical  appeals,  which 
the  convocations  did  not  attempt  to  meddle 
with,  as  they  never  did  with  any  other 
legislation  of  that  kind.  The  Ecc.  Eep. 
p.  XXX.  adds  that  before  the  Act  of  Supre- 
macy in  1534,  "  the  king  had  also  exacted 
from  the  clergy  individually,"  i.  e.  they 
had  all  thought  proper  to  give,  "  a  recogni- 
tion of  the  supremacy  in  which  the  words 
"  so  far  as  is  allowed  by  the  law  of  Chris- 
tianity "  were  omitted,  and  then  the  Act  en- 
acts it  expressly,  and  its  title  is  "  An  Act 
concerning  the  King's  Highness  to  be 
supreme  head  of  the  Church  of  England,  and 
to  have  authority  to  reform  and  redress  all 
errors,  heresies,  and  abuses  in  the  same." 

That  vague  title  of  "supreme  head  "  was 
given  up  by  Elizabeth  in  favour  of  "  the 
only  supreme  governor  in  all  spiritual  or 
ecclesiastical  things  or  causes  as  well  as 
temporal ;  "  and  therefore  the  dispute  about 
the  qualifying  words  of  the  convocation 
subsidy  in  1531  is  really  all  about  nothing ;. 
for  on  one  hand  they  were  never  agreed  to 
by  the  king,  and  the  clergy  were  obliged  to 
abandon  them  collectively  and  individually 
afterwards,  and  the  title  was  later  still  given 
up  for  a  better  by  Elizabeth  and  her  Parlia- 
ment, and  would  have  meant  whatever 
anybody  chose  to  mean  by  it,  whereas  th& 
other  words  "  dominus "  and  "  supreme 
governor  "  are  unmistakable  on  the  question 
of  supremacy  of  the  king's  courts,  and  the 
never-disputed  right  of  Parliament  to  alter 
them  or  set  up  new  ones,  which  is  an 
entirely  different  thing  from  professing  to 
alter  the  doctrines  of  the  Church.  In  this 
respect  all  the  sects  are  on  the  same  footing 
as  the  Church.  They  have  all  at  some  time 
or  other  settled  their  own  standards  of  faith, 
by  trust  deeds  or  other  documents  ;  and  it 
has  been  decided  over  and  over  again  that  if 
one  of  their  ministers  preaches  or  acts 
contrary  to  their  standard  of  faith  the 
courts  of  law  will  eject  him  from  his  ofiice 
and  chapel,  if  applied  to ;  and  they  might, 
on  the  same  day  deprive  one  minister  for 
preaching  Unitarianism  in  certain  chapels, 
and  another  minister  for  preaching  against 
it  in  others.      And    that  would    be    the 


SUPREMACY 

condition  of  the  clergy  if  the  Church  were 
disestablished  and  the  ecclesiastical  courts 
aholished.  Practically  now  clerical  and 
dissenting  complaints  of  that  kind  are  heard 
in  the  last  resort  by  substantially  the  same 
judges,  and  at  any  rate  by  the  same  class  of 
judges,  as  may  be  seen  by  reference  to 
Jvdicial  Committee, 

It  may  be  observed  too  that,  whether  the 
convocations  in  the  time  of  Henry  VIII. 
were  consulted  or  not  (and  they  were  not), 
and  assented  or  not  either  tacitly  or  other- 
wise to  the  establishment  of  the  royal 
delegates  mstead  of  the  Pope  as  the  final 
court  of  appeal,  the  clergy  cannot  possibly 
have  been  prejudiced  by  the  limitation  of 
the  delegates  in  1833,  who  might  up  to 
that  time  be  packed  for  any  given  case,  the 
Crown  being  unrestricted  in  selecting  them 
pro  Jidc  vice,  to  a  fixed  court  of  the  highest 
and  most  experienced  judges.  If  the  change 
had  been  the  other  way  the  clergy  might 
well  have  complained  that  Parliament  was 
depriving  them  of  known  judges  and  of  such 
a  court,  and  giving  to  some  unknown  Crown 
official  the  power  of  summoning  a  packed 
jury  of  anybody  that  he  pleased.  No 
minister  of  the  Crown  now  directs  who 
shall  bo  summoned  to  sit  on  any  case.  For 
a  time  it  was  otherwise,  and  that  was  very 
reasonably  objected  to  and  stopped,  and  the 
judges  arrange  it  among  themselves,  every 
one  of  them  being  at  liberty  to  sit  if  he 
likes. 

It  was  considered  doubtful  in  the  Ec- 
clesiastical Courts  Commission  how  far  the 
bishops  themselves  had  retained  liberty  to 
sit  in  their  own  diocesan  courts  instead  of 
their  official  principals  or  chancellors.  In 
some  dioceses  there  were  records  of  the 
bishops  sitting  themselves  occasionally,  but 
in  very  few ;  nor  does  it  seem  of  much 
consequence,  because  they  were  both  equally 
subject  to  appeal  to  the  metropolitan  court 
in  which  no  archbishop  has  ever  sat  as 
judge.  And  the  same  power,  viz.  the 
State,  which  gave  the  bishops  their  coercive 
juiisdiction,  originally  took  it  away  in  all 
the  most  important  cases  by  the  Clergy 
Discipline  Act  of  1840 ;  only  giving  them 
instead  a  modified  kind  of  jurisdiction  with 
assessors,  which  soon  became  practically 
obsolete  for  reasons  not  necessary  to  explain 
here. 

The  usurpation  by  the  Crown  of  the 
power  of  approving,  and  therefore  dis- 
approving, the  appointment  by  the  two 
primates  of  their  official  principal  or  joint 
Dean  of  Arches  and  judge  of  the  Chancery 
Court  of  York  (who  is  not  the  chancellor) 
under  the  Public  Worship  Regulation  Act, 
was  strangely  allowed  to  pass  without  notice. 
It  appears  doubtful  whether  it  was  perceived 
by  those  whom  it  chiefly  concerned,  from 


SUPEEMACY 


TIS' 


some  questions  put  in  the  Ecc.  Courts  Com- 
mission (see  p.  263,  Ev.).  Nobody  gave  any 
real  objection  to  the  archbishops  being  re- 
quired to  appoint  the  same  judge,  and  there 
are  some  obvious  advantages  in  it;  and  if 
they  ever  could  not  agree,  which  is  unlikely, 
it  might  be  necessary  for  the  Crown  to  act 
as  arbiter,  but  not  to  take  their  place; 
but  certainly  no  more.  It  is  by  no  means 
impossible  that  the  principal  ecclesiastical 
judge  of  all  England  may  some  day  be  a 
iperson  whom  it  is  an  insult  to  the  Church, 
and  to  any  Church  or  sect,  to  appoint. 
Indeed  there  is  absolutely  nothing  now  to 
prevent  an  atheistical  Prime  Minister  from 
appointing  an  atheistic  Dean  of  Arches,, 
and  representative  of  both  archbishops,  if 
he  chooses  to  say  he  is  a  member  of  the- 
Church  of  England,  which  nobody  could 
disprove ;  for  there  is  no  test,  and  such  a 
man  could  still  less  be  proved  to  belong  to  any 
other  Church  or  sect.  Such  is  ecclesiastical 
legislation  nowadays,  in  an  Act  brought  in 
and  carried  ostentatiously  by  bishops  and 
strong  Churchmen  (See  Ecclesiastical 
Courts).     [G.] 

SUPREMACY,  PAPAL.  The  authority 
claimed  by  the  Bishop  of  Rome  by  virtue 
of  his  supposed  succession  to  the  preroga- 
tives of  St.  Peter.  This  authority  is  of 
three  kinds,  viz.:  1.  the  purely  ecclesiastical, 
whereby  the  Pope  claims  to  be  supreme 
governor  of  the  Church  ;  2.  temporal  domi- 
nion, whereby  he  claims  to  rule  a  portion 
of  Italy ;  and  3.  the  universal  sovereignty 
which  he  claims  over  all  the  nations  of  the 
world  in  civil  as  well  as  in  ecclesiastical 
affairs.  This  authority  was  gradually 
claimed  from  the  fifth  century  onwards,, 
each  claim  that  was  admitted  forming  the 
basis  of  a  new  and  more  extravagant  one. 
At  last  the  supremacy  was  claimed  in  the 
widest  terms  by  Pope  Boniface  VIII.  in  the 
famous  Bull  called  "Unam  Sanctam,"  issued 
Nov.  18,  1302,  in  which  the  following  pas- 
sages occur  :  "Therefore  both  the  spiritual 
and  material  sword  are  in  the  power  of  the 
Church ;  but  the  latter  is  to  be  exercised 
on  behalf  of  the  former  by  the  Church ;  the 
former  by  the  hand  of  the  priest,  the  latter 
by  that  of  kings  and  soldiers,  but  at  the- 
bidding  and  by  the  sufferance  of  the  priest. 
But  as  sword  should  be  under  sword,  so 
should  the  temporal  authority  be  subordi- 
nated to  the  spiritual  .  .  .  Moreover  we 
declare,  assert,  define  and  pronounce  that 
it  is  altogether  necessary  to  salvation  that 
every  human  creature  should  be  subject  to 
the  Roman  Pontiff."  Tliis  Bull  is  still  part 
of  the  law  of  the  Church  of  Rome ;  and  in 
the  Creed  of  Pope  Pius  IV.  (a.d.  1564),  to 
which  every  convert  to  Romanism  has  to 
subscribe,  the  following  sentence  occurs  : — 
"  I  recognise  the  holy  Catholic  and  Apostolic 


V20 


SUPREMACY 


Eoman  Church  as  the  mother  and  mistress 
of  all  Churches ;  and  I  promise  and  vow 
true  obedience  to  the  Eoman  Pontiff,  the 
successor  of  blessed  Peter  the  prince  of  the 
Apostles,  and  vicar  of  Jesus  Christ." 

Before  sketching  the  means  by  which 
the  vast  fabric   of  Papal   Supremacy  was 
bmlt  up,  it  will  be  well  to  examine  shortly 
the  theory  of  the  primacy  of  St.  Peter, 
upon  which  the  whole  claim  rests.     It  is 
worthy  of  note  that  this  theory  does  not 
appear  in  the  earliest  ages  of  the  Church, 
but  was  put  forward  when  it  was  found  that 
history  and  reason  were  not  on  the  side  of 
the  Papal  claims.     It  cannot  be  too  clearly 
understood  that  these  claims  are  now  rested 
solely  on  the  supposed  fact  of  St.  Peter's 
supremacy,  and  that  if  that  fact  turns  out 
to  be  groundless  the  whole  fabric  must  fall. 
This    theory  involves    three   suppositions ; 
first,  that  supremacy  over  the  Church  was 
committed  to  St.  Peter ;  secondly,  that  that 
apostle  was  bishop  of  Rome;  and  thii'dly, 
that  his  powers,  whatever  they  were,  extend 
to  his  successors  in  that  see.     Now  of  these 
suppositions  the  first  is  extremely  doubtful, 
resting  as  it  does  upon  two  passages,  viz. 
St.  Matthew  xvi.  18,  19,  and  St.  John  xxi. 
15-17.     But  in  the  first  of  these  passages  it 
is  by  no  means  certain  whether  "  the  rock  " 
referred    to    is  St.   Peter,    the    expression 
having   been   variously   interpreted   of  the 
whole  body  of  the  apostles  and  of  our  Lord 
Himself.     But  even  assuming  "  the  rock  " 
to  be  St.  Peter,  the  verse  gives  no  hint  of 
supremacy.     A  more  likely  interpretation  is 
that  the  zeal  of  St.  Peter  was  a  fovmdation 
on   which  the   Church   would  be  built — ^a 
view  fully  borne  out  by  subsequent  events. 
In  the  second  passage,  "Peed  my  sheep" 
conveys  no  hint  of  such  a  supremacy  as  the 
Pope  claims,  even  taking  into  consideration 
the    fact  that  voifuuve    carries  with   it  a 
sense  of  ruling  which  the  English  "  feed  " 
does  not.    It  is  also  said  that  the  prominence 
always  given  to   St.  Peter's  name  by  the 
sacred  writers  proves  that  he  was  considered 
the  leader  of  the   apostles.     It   doubtless 
does  point  to  a  primacy  of  honour  or  prece- 
dence, which  may  have  been  given  to  him 
because  he  was  the  eldest,  or  for  some  other 
reason.     In  so  far  as  any  one  had  the  presi- 
dency of  the  Apostolic   College,  it  was  St. 
James,  the  Lord's  brother,  not   St.  Peter, 
who  held  that  office.     The  second  suppo- 
sition, that  St.  Peter  was  bishop  of  Rome,  is 
almost    certainly  false.     His   having  held 
such  a  position  would  have  been  inconsistent 
with  the  position  of  St.  Paul  at  Rome,  and 
with  the  omission  of  St.  Peter's  name  from 
the  salutations  in  Rom.  xvi.     It  is  far  more 
likely  that  St.  Peter  was  bishop  of  Antioch, 
in  which  case,  on  the  Romanist  theory,  the 
patriarch  of  that    city  ought    to   be   the 


SUPEEMACy 

sovereign  of  the  Church.  But  in  point  of 
fact,  it  is  not  likely  that  local  diocesan 
episcopacy  was  established  at  all  during  the 
Apostolic  age.  Since  neither  of  the  first 
two  suppositions  which  the  Petrine  claim 
involves  can  be  established,  the  third — that 
St.  Peter's  powers  extended  to  his  successors 
— clearly  falls  to  the  ground.  Nor  is  there 
the  smallest  evidence  in  Scripture  or  else- 
where that  any  pre-eminence  which  may 
have  been  allowed  to  St.  Peter  was  intended 
to  extend  beyond  himself. 

Though  the  theory  of  St.  Peter's  supre- 
macy has  been  for  centuries  the  avowed 
basis  of  the  Papal  claims,  the  power  of  the 
Popes  was  really  built  on  a  very  different 
foundation.  The  growth  of  that  power — 
one  of  the  most  interesting  facts  in  human 
history — wiM  now  be  briefly  traced,  under 
the  three  heads  before  referred  to. 

I.  The  ecclesiastical  sovereignty  of  the 
Pope  is  due  to  a  variety  of  causes.     Pore- 
most  amongst  these  is  the  civil  position  of 
Rome  during  the  first  three  centuries  of  our 
era.     It  was  the  regular  practice  of  the 
Church  to  establish  metropolitan  sees  in  the 
civil  metropolis  of  each  district  (see  Metro- 
politan), and  Rome  was  thus  not  only  a 
metropolitan,  but  t!ie  metropolitan  see  of 
the  world.     A  certain  primacy  of  honour 
was  therefore  accorded  to  its  bishop,  and 
this  was  ratified  by  two,  at  least,  of  the 
great   General    Councils  (Cone.    Constant. 
can.    iii. ;    Cone.    Chalced.     can.    xxviii.). 
Another  cause  of  the  respect  in  which  Rome 
was  held  in  primitive  times  was  the  un- 
swei-ving  orthodoxy  of  her  Church :  while 
the  East  was  eaten  up  by  Arianism   and 
every  other  form  of  heresy,  Rome  remained 
firm  in  the  orthodox  faith.    These  two  causes 
combined  to  render  the  Roman  Church,  and 
therefore  the  Roman  bishop,  an  important 
factor  in  early  Christendom.     But  still  there 
was  no  authority  conceded  to  the  bishop  of 
Rome  beyond  that  possessed  by  other  pri- 
mates.    The  first  step  in  the  direction  of 
Papal  Supremacy  was  taken  by  the  Council 
of  Sardica  (a.d.  347).     The  third,  fourth, 
and  fifth  canons  of  that  council  provide  that 
if  any  bishop,  deposed  by  the  judgment  of 
his  comprovincial  bishops,  shall  appeal  to 
Rome,  the  bishop  of  Rome  may,  if  he  thinks 
fit,  remit  the  cause  for  a  new  hearing,  or 
appoint  delegates  to  hear  it.     Now  it  is  to 
be  observed,  first,  that  the  canons  of  this 
Council  of  Sardica  are  of  doubtful  authenti- 
city, and  were  never  acknowledged  in  the 
East;    secondly,  that    the  "placet"  with 
which  canons  usually  conclude  is  wanting 
to  two  of  them ;  and  that,  thirdly,  assuming 
their  genuineness  and  authority,  ihey  in  no 
way  sanction  the  extravagant  pretensions  of 
the  Pope.    It  afterwards  suited  the  Pope  to 
c'aim  these  canons  as  canons  of  the  great 


SUPREMACY 

Council  of  Nica;a,  and  also  greatly  to  ex- 
aggerate the  powers  wliich  they  gave  to  him. 
During  the  pontificate  of  Leo  I.  (P.  440- 
455)  the  Emperor  Valentinian  III.  confirmed 
the  appealed  jurisdiction  of  the  bishop  of 
Eome. 

The  fall  of  the  Western  Empire  (a.d.  476) 
and  the  consequent  nominal  subjection  of 
Home  to  Constantinople  was  another  element 
in  the  growth  of  the  Pope's  ecclesiastical 
supremacy.  He  retained  all  the  prestige 
derived  from  the  majesty  of  the  Roman 
name,  while  he  was  set  free  from  the  con- 
stant check  afforded  by  imperial  supervision 
and  control.  Daring  the  fifth  and  sixth 
centuries  the  Papal  power  was  silently  but 
surely  growing,  it  is  to  this  period  that 
we  must  ascribe  the  foundation  of  three 
great  pillars  of  Papal  authority — the 
Decretals,  the  institution  of  Papal  legates, 
and  the  grant  of  the  pallium  to  metro- 
politans. 

(i.)  Papal  decrees  had  their  origin  during 
the  pontificate  of  Siricius  (a.d.  385-398). 
The  archbishop  of  Avragon  had  asked  the 
advice  of  Damasus,  Siricius'  immediate  pre- 
decessor. Siricius,  who  sent  the  answer 
after  Damasus'  death,  referred  to  the 
"Deoreta"  of  Liberius  (P.  352-356).  The 
same  Pope  sent  decrees  of  his  own  to  the 
African  Church,  and  somewhat  later, 
Innocent  I.  wrote  a  letter  to  the  bishop  of 
G-ubbio,in  which  he  declared  that  all  Western 
Churches  must  follow  the  rule  of  Rome. 
From  this  time  onwards  Papal  decrees  were 
a  recognised  part  of  the  law  of  Christendom. 
There  was  an  authorised  collection  of  them 
by  Dionysius,  to  which  was  added  that  of 
the  authentic  councils,  under  the  name  of 
Isidore  of  Seville.  But  after  the  lapse  of 
five  centuries,  during  the  pontificate  of 
Nicholas  I.  (P.  858-867)  a  new  collection 
ma,de  its  appearance,  purporting  to  consist 
of  the  decrees  of  the  twenty  oldest  Popes, 
and  the  acts  of  several  unauthentic  councils. 
This  collection  is  now  universally  acknow- 
ledged to  have  been  forged.  Nicholas  I.  for 
his  own  purposes  admitted  the  genuineness 
of  the  Decretals,  which  thenceforward  were 
a  recognised  part  of  the  law  of  the  Church. 
These  Decretals  not  only  supplied  precedents 
for  Papal  action,  but,  by  their  very  ex- 
istence, proclaimed  the  Pope  the  supreme 
legislative,  as  well  as  administrative, 
authority.  They  were  ultimately  codified 
and  promulgated  anew  by  Gregory  IX. 
(P.  1227-1241)  as  the  statute  law  of  Chris- 
tendom. 

(ii.)  Vicars  apostolic  were  first  appointed 
by  Pope  Damasus  (a.d.  380)  when  lUyria 
was  ceded  to  the  jurisdiction  of  the. West- 
ern Empire.-  Pope  Leo  I.  sent  legates  to 
the  Council  of  Chalcedon  (a.d.  451)  who 
took  precedence  of  all  other  bishops.     Until 


SUPREMACY 


721 


the  tenth  century  special  legates  called 
legates  "  a  latere  "  were  sent  only  on  great 
occasions.  The  legatine  commission  was  as  a 
rule  entrusted  to  some  great  metropolitan 
of  the  nation  in  which  it  was  exercised ; 
thus  the  archbishop  of  Canterbury  was 
perpetual  legate  in  England  and  was  thence 
called  "  legatus  natus."  But  after  the 
tenth  century  the  legate  "  a  latere  "  became 
a  more  frequent  visitor,  and  was  generally 
very  unpopular,  as  he  lived  at  the  expense 
of  the  bishops  of  the  province,  of  whom  he 
took  precedence,  although  he  might  be,  and 
not  unfrequently  was,  only  in  deacon's 
orders.  It  is  clear  that  the  legatine  system, 
in  both  its  forms,  was  highly  favourable  to 
the  development  of  Papal  power. 

(iii.)  One  very  great  barrier  to  the  advance 
of  Papal  authority  was  the  power  wielded 
by  metropolitans  (vid.  Metropolitan).  These 
great  prelates  often  offered  an  effectual  re- 
sistance to  Papal  interference.  In  order  to 
rivet  the  Papal  authority  on  the  necks  of 
metropolitans,  the  Popes  devised  the  plan 
of  granting  the  pallium  to  these  prelates. 
This  was  a  vestment  resembling  a  modern 
stole,  but  hanging  down  both  behind  and 
before.  It  was  originally  conferred  by  the 
emperors  on  the  patriarchs  about  the  end  of 
the  fourth  century.  About  a.d.  500,  Pope 
Symmachus  gave  it  to  his  legate  Cassarius 
of  Aries.  After  this  time,  it  was  given 
occasionally,  as  a  matter  of  high  favour,  to 
vicars  apostolic.  In  a.d.  743  Pope  Zacharias 
conferred  it  on  all  the  metropolitans  of 
Graul.  But  they  were  obliged  to  solicit 
earnestly  for  it,  and,  for  a  long  time,  it  was 
never  conferred  except  upon  those  metro- 
politans who  went  to  Rome  to  ask  for  it, 
and  promised  to  obey  the  Pope.  Gregory 
VII.  forbad  metropolitans  to  ordain  until 
they  had  received  the  pallium,  and  some  of 
his  successors  made  it  a  means  of  raising 
money. 

These  three  causes,  all  originating  about 
the  fifth  century,  contributed  to  increase 
the  power  of  the  Popes.  This  power  was 
also  materially  helped  in  later  times  by  the 
monastic  system.  That  system  had  indeed 
grown  up  independently  of  the  Papacy; 
but,  as  Milman  says,  "  monasticism  as- 
cended the  Papal  throne  in  the  person  of 
Gregory  the  Great"  (a.d.  590-604).  In  the 
monastic  orders  the  Popes  saw  an  organ- 
ization which  they  might  turn  to  their 
own  advantage.  For  a  long  time  (until 
about  the  twelfth  century),  monks,  like 
other  clergy,  were  under  the  control  of  their 
bishop.  But  about  that  time  the  Pope 
exempted  them  from  episcopal  supervision, 
and  made  them  subject  to  himself  alone. 
In  the  thirteenth  century,  the  mendicant 
orders  arose,  and  formed  a  vast  spiritual 
police,  independent  of,  and  sometimes  hostile 

3  A 


722 


STJPKEMACY 


to,  the  parochial  clergy,  and  acknowledging 
the  Pope  as  its  head. 

II.  The  temporal  power  of  the  Pope 
belongs  rather  to  political  than  to  ecclesi- 
astical history ;  but  as  it  has  had  a  consider- 
able share  in  determining  the  Pope's  ecclesi- 
astical position,  it  is  not  irrelevant  briefly  to 
sketch  its  growth. 

In  the  earliest  ages  the  bishop  of  Rome 
had  no  more  temporal  power  than  was  pos- 
sessed by  any  other  bishop.  But  after  the 
fall  of  the  Western  Empire,  he  was  naturally 
looked  to  as  the  defender  of  Italy  against 
the  barbarian  invaders.  While  nominally 
subject  to  the  Emperor  at  Constantinople— 
whose  authority  was  explicitly  recognised 
by  more  than  one  Pope — the  real  power 
exercised  by  that  monarch  in  Italy  was 
small.  During  the  sixth  century,  the 
conquests  of  Belisarius  restored  Italy  to 
Justinian,  the  Gothic  monarchy  was  over- 
thrown, and  an  exarch  ruled  at  Ravenna  in 
the  name  of  the  Eastern  Emperor.  He  for 
a  short  time  ruled  the  whole  of  Italy,  but 
the  conquest  of  the  Lombards  soon  set 
limits  to  his  dominions,  which  were  finally 
restricted  to  the  territory  afterwards  known 
as  the  "  Patrimony  of  St.  Peter,"  and  in 
more  modem  times  as  the  "  States  of  the 
Church."  This  exarchate  continued  for 
two  centuries,  subject  to  the  Emperor  at 
Constantinople :  but  the  advancing  power 
of  Mohammedanism  rendered  it  increasingly 
difficultfor  that  prince  to  govern  or  defend  his 
distant  dependency.  Things  were  therefore 
ripe  for  a  separation,  when  the  pretext  was 
supplied  by  the  opposition  offered  by  Leo 
the  Isaurian  (Emp.  717-741)  to  the  worship 
of  images.  This  caused  Pope  Gregory  II. 
(a.d.  715-731)  to  throw  off  for  ever  the  yoke 
of  Constantinople.  His  policy  was  continued 
by  his  successor,  Gregory  III.  (a.d.  731-741), 
and  under  these  two  Popes  the  Republic  of 
Rome  was  revived.  This  is  the  real  date  of 
the  foundation  of  the  temporal  power  of  the 
Pope.  The  so-called  "Donation  of  Con- 
stantine,"  by  which  the  patrimony  of  St. 
Peter  was  granted  to  the  bishop  of  Rome, 
is  a  forgery  of  later  times. 

The  Popes,  however,  soon  found  that  they 
had  exchanged  a  distant  master  for  one  at 
their  gates.  The  power  of  the  Lombards  was 
a  standing  menace  to  their  newly-founded 
state.  Under  these  circumstances  they  found 
it  necessary  to  invoke  the  aid  of  the  Pranks. 
Charles  Martel,  the  deliverer  of  Christendom 
from  the  Saracens,  was  unable  to  help 
Gregory  III.  But  his  son,  Pepin,  made 
two  expeditions  into  Italy,  chastised  the 
Lombards,  and  secured  Rome,  at  the  request 
of  Pope  Stephen  III.  (a.d.  753-757).  Pope 
Zacharias  (a.d.  741-752)  had  already  paid  for 
the  material  assistance  of  the  Pranks  by  his 
decision  in  favour  of  the  transference  of  the 


SUPREMACY 

kingly  title  from  the  feeble  Childeric  III. 
to  the  famous  founder  of  the  Carlovingian 
House.  As  Gibbon  well  observes,  "  The 
mutual  obligations  of  the  Popes  and  the 
Carlovingian  family  form  the  important  link 
of  ancient  and  modem,  of  civil  and  ecclesi- 
astical history."  Charlemagne,  Pepin's  still 
more  famous  son,  conquered  the  Lombards 
in  A.D.  774,  and  confirmed  the  donation  of 
his  father  to  the  Holy  See.  The  title  of 
Patrician  of  Rome  was  conferred  on  Charle- 
magne, and  for  twenty-six  years  he  governed 
Italy.  During  this  time  the  revolt  from 
the  Eastern  Empire  was  consummated. 
But  on  Christmas  Day,  a.d.  800,  when 
Charlemagne  was  in  Rome,  he  was  suddenly 
crowned  as  Emperor  by  Pope  Leo  III.  In 
the  minds  of  all  the  actors  this  transaction 
was  more  than  the  revival  of  the  Western 
Empire,  which  had  been  in  abeyance  for 
more  than  four  centuries.  It  was  the 
transference  of  the  imperial  power  from 
Constantinople  to  Rome,  and  from  the 
person  of  the  Empress  Irene  to  Charlemagne. 
This  transference  was  effected  by  Papal 
authority,  and  it  is  easy  to  see  the  enormous 
value  of  the  transaction  to  the  Pope.  It 
gave  colour  to  all  his  subsequent  claims  to 
the  disposal  of  the  thrones  of  the  world. 
For  more  than  four  centuries  and  a  half  the 
Holy  Roman  Empire  was  the  greatest  power 
of  the  Western  World.  The  election  to 
that  empire  was,  indeed,  from  the  time  of 
Otho  I.  (a.d.  963)  vested  in  certain  German 
princes,  but  the  authority  of  the  Emperor 
depended  upon  his  coronation  by  the  Pope. 
This  gave  the  Pope  ample  opportunity  for 
interfering  in  the  affairs  of  Europe,  and  this 
temporal  power,  in  its  turn,  enabled  him  to 
augment  his  ecclesiastical  authority. 

III.  This  brings  us  to  the  third  sort  of 
supremacy  claimed  by  the  Pope,  viz., 
supremacy  over  the  princes  of  the  world. 
The  idea  of  this  supremacy  was  first 
broached  by  Gelasius  I.  (a.d.  492),  who, 
two  years  before,  had  recognised  the  Em- 
peror Anastasius  as  his  sovereign,  and  had 
said  that  the  ecclesiastical  and  civil  powers 
ought  not  to  interfere  with  each  other.  A 
similar  acknowledgment  was  made  a  century 
later  by  Gregory  I.  The  deposition  of 
Childeric  HI.  by  Zacharias  has  been  men- 
tioned, but  in  it  the  Pope  seems  only  to 
have  acted  when  requested  to  arbitrate. 
The  right  to  dispose  of  temporal  sove- 
reignties was  claimed  by  Nicholas  II.  (a.d. 
1059),  when  he  confirmed  the  Duke  of 
Sicily  in  his  dominions,  and  received  his 
oath  of  fealty.  A  few  years  earlier  (a.d. 
1054)  Leo  IX.  had  asserted  the  indepen- 
dence of  the  Pope  of  any  earthly  power.  It 
is  worth  noticing  that,  just  ninety  years 
before,  Leo  VIII.,  a  creature  of  the  Emperor 
Otho  I.,  had  for  ever  vested  the  right  of 


SUPREMACY 

approving  the  Pope  in  the  Emperor.  It  is 
for  Romanists  to  decide  which  of  these 
Pontiffs  was  infallible.  Gregory  VII.  claimed 
the  right  of  deposing  the  Emperor  on  his 
own  sole  authority,  a  right  which  he  himself 
exercised  in  the  famous  case  of  Henry  IV. 
(a.d.  1075).  From  this  time  onwards  these 
depositions  were  not  infrequent,  among  the 
most  celebrated  instances  being  the  deposi- 
tions of  Otho  IV.  by  Innocent  III.  (a.d. 
1212),  and  of  Prederick  II.  by  Innocent  IV. 
<A.D.  1245). 

This  feudal  supremacy  was  strengthened 
by  the  Crusades,  which,  originating  in  reaUy 
heroic  and  religious  feelings,  soon  de- 
generated into  a  mere  engine  of  Papal 
tyranny.  They  are  responsible  for  the 
beginning  of  the  system  of  pardons  and 
indulgences.  These  were  promised  by  Pope 
Urban  II.  at  the  Council  of  Clermont  (a.d. 
1095).  Innocent  III.  claimed  the  power  of 
remitting  all  sius.  This  pretended  control 
of  the  keys  of  heaven  was  one  of  the  chief 
supports  of  the  tyranny  which  the  Popes  for 
•centuries  exercised  over  the  minds  of  men. 

Such  was,  in  outline,  the  growth  of  the 
Papal  Supremacy.  It  would  carry  us  far 
beyond  the  limits  of  an  article  were  we  to 
attempt  to  trace  all  its  development.  It  is 
«nough  to  say  that  it  grew  steadily  by 
successive  encroachments  of  the  kind  indi- 
cated, throughout  the  eighth  and  ninth 
centuries.  During  the  end  of  the  ninth, 
the  tenth,  and  the  first  half  of  the  eleventh 
centuries  (with  the  exception  of  a  short 
period  of  revival  imder  the  Othos,  a.d.  963- 
1008),  it  suffered  an  eclipse.  But  it  rose 
from  its  temporary  obscurity  into  greater 
power  than  ever  from  the  middle  of  the 
eleventh  century,  and  irom  the  pontificate 
of  Gregory  VII.  (1073-1085)  for  more  than 
two  centuries,  the  Papacy  was  the  dominant 
influence  in  the  Western  world.  The 
zenith  of  Papal  power  extends  from  the 
accession  of  Innocent  III.  (a.d.  1198)  to 
the  death  of  Boniface  VIII.  (a.d.  1303). 
With  the  faU  of  the  latter  Pontiff  comes 
the  beginrung  of  the  end  of  Papal  greatness. 
The  reason  is  to  be  found  in  the  fact  that 
■during  this  period  the  idea  of  national 
independence  took  the  place  of  that  of  an 
empire  extending,  in  theory  at  least,  over 
the  world.  When  the  Popes  himted  the 
bouse  of  Hohenstaufen  off  the  face  of  the 
earth,  they  little  tiiought  that  they  were 
cutting  away  the  mainstay  of  their  own 
power.  With  the  blameless  Conradin  (ob. 
1268)  the  Holy  Roman  Empire,  as  a  politi- 
cal power,  not  as  a  name,  came  virtually  to 
an  end.  The  theory  of  the  two  lights — 
spiritual  and  political — illuminating  the 
world  gave  way  to  the  fact  of  independent 
nations  administering  their  own  civil  and 
•ecclesiastical  affairs.    It  was  the  resistance 


SURPLICE 


723 


of  Philip  the  Fair  (a.d.  1285-1314)  to  Boni- 
face VIII.  that  first  really  shook  the  Papal 
power  to  its  centre.  But  it  might  have 
survived  even  that  shock  had  it  not  been 
for  the  disastrous  policy,  initiated  by  Cle- 
ment V.  (a.d.  1305-1314),  of  removing  the 
seat  of  the  Papacy  to  Avignon.  There  it 
remained,  practically  under  the  control  of 
the  King  of  France,  until  Gregory  XI. 
(a.d.  1370-1378)  returned  to  Rome.  His 
death  was  succeeded  by  the  great  schism  of 
the  West,  which  lasted  thirty-eight  years, 
during  which  there  were  always  two  Popes, 
one  at  Avignon,  the  other  at  Rome.  At 
length  the  Council  of  Pisa  (a.d.  1409) 
declared  both  the  claimants  of  the  Papacy 
improperly  elected,  and  proceeded  to  elect  a 
new  Pope,  John  XXIII.  Thus,  as  neither 
of  the  deposed  prelates  accepted  the  sen- 
tence, there  were  three  Popes.  The  Council 
of  Constance  (a.d.  1416)  deposed  John 
XXIII.,  and  put  an  end  to  the  schism.  By 
electing  a  man  of  high  character  and  ability 
as  Martin  V.,  it  for  a  time  retrieved  the 
credit  of  the  Papacy ;  but  it  had  proclaimed 
to  all  the  world  that  a  Pope,  even  if  canoni- 
cally  elected,  could  be  deposed  by  a  council. 
By  this  act  the  Western  Church  formally 
repudiated  the  supremacy  of  the  Pope,  and 
it  only  remained  for  a  considerable  part  of 
the  Roman  Church,  a  century  and  a  half 
later,  to  throw  off  his  authority  altogether. 

[Authorities.  The  chief  authority  for  the 
history  of  the  Popes  to  the  Council  of 
Constance  is  Milman's  Latin  Christianity. 
Barrow's  Treatise  on  the  PopSs  Supremacy 
is  an  exhaustive  examination  of  the  theo- 
logical part  of  the  controversy.  Much 
useful  information  may  also  be  gathered 
from  Hussey's  Rise  of  the  Papal  Power; 
Bryoe's  Holy  Roman  Empire;  Hallam's 
Middle  Ages,  chap.  vii. ;  Gibbon's  Decline 
and  Fall  of  the  Roman  Empire,  chap.  xlix. ; 
and  Palmer's  Treatise  on  the  Church,  Part 
vii.]     [B.  R.  V.  M.] 

SQROINGLE.  The  belt  by  which  the 
cassock  is  fastened  round  the  waist. 

SURETY  (See  Sponsors). 

SURPLICE.  A  white  linen  garment, 
worn  by  the  Christian  clergy  and  other 
persons  specially  engaged  in  the  celebra- 
tion of  Divine  services,  and  also,  on  certaia 
days,  by  members  of  colleges,  whether 
clerical  or  lay.  It  is,  in  Latin,  superpelliceum, 
a  name  which  Cardinal  Bona  says  was  not 
older  than  600  years  before  his  time  (the 
middle  of  the  seventeenth  century),  and  was 
so  called  from  the  white  garment  which 
was  placed  by  ecclesiastics,  super  pelles, 
over  the  garments  of  dressed  skins  worn  by 
the  Northern  nations. — Bona,  Rer.  Liturg. 
lib.  i.  c.  xxiv.  It  may  be  called  the  uniform 
of  the  Church  in  Divine  service. 

This  habit  seems  to  have  been  originally 
3  A  2 


724 


SUKPLICE 


copied  from  the  vestments  of  the  Jewish 
priests,  who,  by  God's  own  apiMintment, 
were  to  put  on  a  white  linen  epliod  at  the 
time  of  public  service.  And  its  antiquity 
in  the  Christian  Church  may  he  seen  from 
Gregory  Nazianzen,  who  advised  the  priests 
to  cultivate  purity,  because  a  little  sjMt  is 
soon  seen  in  a  white  garment ;  but  more  ex- 
pressly from  St.  Jerome,  who,  reproving  the 
needless  scruples  of  such  as  opposed  the  use 
of  it,  says,  "  what  offence  can  it  be  to  God, 
for  a  bishop  or  priest  to  proceed  to  the  com- 
munion in  a  white  garment  ?  " 

It  is  by  no  means  unprobahle  that  the 
surplice  was  in  very  ancient  times  not 
different  from  the  albe  (See  Albe).  In 
fact,  it  only  varies  from  that  garment,  even 
now,  in  having  wider  sleeves.  The  inferior 
clergy  were  accustomed  to  wear  the  albe  at 
Divine  service,  as  we  find  by  the  Council  of 
Narhoime,  a.d.  589,  which  forbad  them  to 
take  it  off  until  the  liturgy  was  ended. 
Probably  in  after  ages  it  was  thought 
advisable  to  make  a  distinction  between  the 
dresses  -w^ich  the  superior  and  inferior 
orders  of  clergy  wore  at  the  liturgy ;  and 
then  a  difference  was  made  in  the  sleeves. — 
Palmer's  Ortg.  Liturg.  ii.  319. 

The  short  surplice  adopted  in  the  Eoman 
Church  is  a  corruption,  as  Cardinal  Bona 
confesses  {Rer.  Liturg.  u.  s.).  He  says  that 
Stephen  of  Tournay,  who  lived  A.D.  1180, 
shows  that  the  sm-plice  formerly  reached  to 
the  feet ;  and  so  likewise  "  Honorius  de 
Yestibus  Clericorum : "  and  that  in  the 
course  of  time  it  was  shortened,  as  it  appears 
from  the  Council  of  Basle,  sess.  21,  which 
commanded  the  clergy  to  have  surplices 
reaching  below  the  middle  of  the  leg.  He 
adds  that  they  are  now  so  much  shortened 
as  scarcely  to  reach  to  the  knee. 

A  fashion  of  wearing  such  short  sur- 
plices, and  even  if  not  short,  as  scanty  and 
free  from  folds  as  possible,  has  lately  come 
into  vogue  among  some  of  the  clergy  in 
England.  It  is  clearly  contrary  to  the 
ancient  use  in  the  Church  of  England,  not 
only  since,  but  before  the  Reformation,  as 
is  evident  from  old  brasses,  and  from  various 
episcopal  injunctions  for  a  long  and  full 
surplice,  with  long  sleeves.  The  long 
EngHsh  surphce,  reaching  to  the  ground, 
with  flowing  sleeves,  is  acknowledged  even 
by  the  Roman  ritualists  {vide  Goar  and  Dr. 
Rook)  to  he  more  primitive  than  the  short 
sleeveless  garment  of  Rome  (Jebh's  Choral 
Service,  p.  219).  By  the  58lh  canon,  "  every 
minister  saying  the  public  prayers  or  minis- 
tering the  sacraments  or  other  rites  of  the 
Church  shall  wear  a  comely  and  decent 
surphce  with  sleeves;  and  the  matter,  de- 
cency, and  comeliness  of  the  surplice  shall 
be  decided  by  the  bishop." 

Wearing  a  go^vn  instead  of  a  surplice  in 


SURROGATE 

the  pulpit  has  become  a  nearly  obsolete 
badge  of  what  an  article  in  the  Quarterli/ 
Review  of  Jan.  1881,  on  "  The  Ritualists  and 
the  Law,"  called  Low  Church  ritualism, 
although  it  came  to  the  conclusion  that  the 
Privy  Council  would  probably  hold  that 
there  was  no  absolute  prohibition  of  it  in 
any  rubric  or  canon,  having  regard  also  to 
usage.  But  for  that  usage,  without  repeat- 
ing the  arguments  here,  the  case  seems 
legally  clear  in  favour  of  the  surplice,  unless 
it  can  be  made  out  that  preaching  is  not 
covered  by  the  words  "  in  all  times  of  their 
ministration,"  which  would  he  rather  diffi- 
cult, especially  as  there  is  no  provision  in 
the  rubrics  or  canons  for  any  other  vestment 
in  preaching.  'The  74th  canon  has  no  refer- 
ence to  "  decency  of  apparel "  in  church. 
However,  the  question  is  gradually  settling 
itself,  and  the  gown-wearing  ritualists  are 
fast  dying  out.  In  many  country  churches, 
before  all  these  recent  changes,  the  gown 
had  never  got  into  the  pulpit  at  all ;  and 
though  its  use  was  in  one  sense  common,  it 
never  had  been  general,  nor  ever  seen  at  all 
in  cathedrals  or  collegiate  churches,  which 
are  the  natural  dopositaries  and  constant, 
witnesses  of  ancient  usage,  while  the  practice 
in  parish  churches  depends  on  each  new 
incumbent  (See  Advertisements  and  Ornor- 
ments).     [G.] 

SUKPLICE  DAYS.  According  to  the 
17th  canon,  "all  masters  and  fellows  of 
colleges  or  halls,  and  all  the  scholars  and 
students  in  either  of  the  universities,  shall 
in  their  churches  and  chapels,  upon  all 
Sundays,  holy-days,  and  their  eves,  at  the 
time  of  Divine  service,  wear  surplices  ac- 
cording to  the  order  of  the  Church  of 
England;  and  such  as  are  graduates  shall 
agreeably  wear  with  their  surplices  such 
hoods  as  do  severally  appertain  unto  their 
degrees."  Saturday  evening,  it  is  to  be 
observed,  as  the  eve  of  Sunday,  has  always 
been  considered  as  coming  within  this  rule. 
The  colleges  in  the  universities  of  Cam- 
bridge and  Dublin  construe  this  rule  as 
applying  to  all  their  members ;  those  of 
Oxford,  Christ  Church  excepted,  to  the 
foundation  members  onlj' ;  and  at  Cambridge 
too  noblemen  do  not  wear  surplices.  By  the 
25th  canon,  the  use  of  the  surplice  is  prescribed 
daily  to  the  deans,  masters,  heads  of  col- 
legiate churches,  canons,  and  prebendaries. 

SURROGATE  (from  Lat.  sub,  under, 
and  rogare,  to  ask  for  and  so  to  elect  or  ap- 
point under).  Surrogate  is  one  who  is 
substituted  or  appointed  in  the  room  of 
another.  Thus  the  office  of  granting  licences 
for  marriage  in  lieu  of  banns,  being  in 
the  bishop  of  the  diocese  by  his  chancellor, 
the  inconvenience  of  a  journey  to  the  seat 
of  episcopal  jurisdiction  is  obviated  by  the 
appointment  of  clergymen  in  the  principal 


SUESUM  CORDA 

towns  of  the  diocese  as  surrogates,  with  the 
power  of  granting  such  licences. 

By  the  statute  of  the  26  Geo.  II.  c. 
33,  No  surrogate,  deputed  by  any  ecclesi- 
astical judge,  who  hath  power  to  grant 
licences  of  marriage,  shall  grant  any  such 
licence  before  he  hath  taken  an  oath  before 
the  said  judge,  faithfully  to  execute  his 
office  according  to  law,  to  the  best  of  his 
knowledge  ;  and  hath  given  security  by  his 
boud  in  the  sum  of  £100  to  the  bishop  of 
the  diocese,  for  the  due  and  faithful  execu- 
tion of  his  office.  All  ecclesiastical  judges 
may  appoint  surrogates  to  act  for  them  in 
cases  of  necessity  (Ecc.  Courts  Bep.  1738). 
"  Letters  of  request  cite  the  party  to  appear 
before  you  (Dean  of  Arches)  or  your  surro- 
<^ate." 

"  simSUM  CORDA  {Uft  up  your 
hearts).  St.  Cyprian,  in  the  third  century, 
attests  the  use  of  the  form  "  Lift  up  your 
hearts,"  and  its  response,  in  the  liturgy  of 
Africa  (Cyp.  de  Orat.  Dam.  p.  152.  Oper. 
ed.  Fell).  St.  Augustine,  at  the  beginning 
of  the  fifth  century,  speaks  of  these  words 
as  being  used  in  all  churches  (de  Iter.  Belig. 
c.  3).  And  accordingly  we  find  them 
placed  at  the  beginning  of  the  Anaphora,  or 
canon  (or  solemn  prayers),  in  the  liturgies 
of  Antioch  and  Cajsarea,  Constantinople 
and  Rome,  Africa,  Gaul,  and  Spain.  How 
long  these  introductory  sentences  have  been 
used  in  England  it  would  be  in  vain  to 
inquire :  we  have  no  reason,  however,  to 
doubt  that  they  are  as  old  as  Christianity 
itself  in  these  countries.  The  Galilean  and 
Italian  Churches  used  them,  and  Christianitj' 
with  its  liturgy  probably  came  to  the  British 
Isles  from  the  former  of  those  Churches. 
We  may  be  certain,  at  all  events,  that  they 
liave  been  used  in  the  English  liturgy  ever 
eince  the  time  of  Augustine,  archbishop  of 
Canterbiiry,  in  595. 

It  appears  that  these  sentences  were  pre- 
ceded by  a  salutation  or  benediction  in  the 
ancient  liturgies.  According  to  Theodoret, 
the  beginning  of  the  mystical  liturgy  or 
most  solemn  prayers,  was  that  apostolic 
benediction,  "  1'he  grace  of  our  Lord  Jesus 
Christ,  and  the  love  of  God,  and  the  fellow- 
ship of  the  Holy  Ghost,  be  with  you  all." 
The  same  was  also  alluded  to  by  Chrysostom, 
when  he  was  a  presbyter  of  the  Church  of 
Antioch.  We  find  that  this  benediction, 
with  the  response  of  the  people,  "  And  with 
thy  spirit,"  has  all  along  preserved  its  place 
in  the  East ;  for  in  the  liturgies  of  Cajsarea, 
Constantinople,  Antioch,  and  Jerusalem,  it 
is  uniformly  placed  at  the  begiiming  of  the 
Anaphora,  just  before  the  form,  "  Lift  up 
your  hearts."  In  Egypt,  Africa,  and  Italy, 
the  apostolic  benediction  was  not  used  at 
this  place,  but  instead  of  it  the  priest  said, 
"  The  Lord  be  with  you,"  and  the  people 


SWEDENBORGIANS 


725 


replied,  "  And  with  thy  spirit."  In  Spain, 
and  probably  Gaul,  as  now  in  England,  there 
was  no  salutation  before  the  introductory 
entences. 

Priest.  Lift  up  your  Sacerdos.  Sursum  corda. 
hearts. 

Answer.  We  lift  them  Bespons.     Habemus  ad 

up  uuto  the  Lord.  Dominum. 

Priest.  Let     us     give  Sacerdos.    Gratias  aga- 

thajilifi  unto  our  Lord  God.  mus  Domino  Deo  nostro. 

Answer.  It  ia  meet  and  llespons.      Dignum    et 

right  so  to  d  '.  justum  est. 

Palmer,  Oi-ig.  Liturg.  li.  1H. 

SUSANNAH,  THE  HISTORY  OP.  An 
apocryphal  book  now  struck  out  of  our 
Calendar  of  Lessons.  It  has  generally  been 
esteemed  a  fable.  Origan,  however,  wrote 
expressly  in  defence  of  it.  The  Church  of 
Rome  allows  it  to  be  of  equal  authority 
with  the  Book  of  Daniel. 

SUSPENSION.  In  the  laws  of  the 
Church  we  read  of  two  sorts  of  suspen- 
sion ;  one  relating  solely  to  the  clergy,  the 
other  extending  also  to  the  laity.  That 
which  relates  solely  to  the  clergy  is  sus- 
pension from  office  and  benefice  jointly,  or 
from  office  or  benefice  singly ;  and  may  be 
called  a  temporary  degradation,  or  depri- 
vation of  both.  And  the  penalty  upon 
a  clergyman  officiating  after  suspension, 
if  he  shall  persist  therein  after  a  reproof 
from  the  bishop  (by  the  ancient  canon 
law),  that  he  shall  be  excommunicated  all 
manner  of  ways.  The  penalty  now  is  signi- 
fication for  contempt,  which  means  imprison- 
ment. The  other  sort  of  suspension,  which 
extends  also  to  the  laity,  is  suspension  ah 
ingressu  ecdesix,  or  from  the  hearing  of 
Divine  service,  and  receiving  the  Holy 
Communion ;  which  may  therefore  be  called 
a  temporary  excommunication. 

SWEDBNBORGIANS.  This  body  of 
Christians  claims  to  possess  an  entirely  new 
dispensation  of  doctrinal  truth,  derived  from 
the  theological  writings  of  Emanuel  Sweden- 
borg ;  and,  as  the  name  imports,  they  re- 
fuse to  be  numbered  with  the  sects  of  which 
the  general  body  of  Christendom  is  at 
present  composed. 

Emanuel  Baron  Swedenborg  was  born 
at  Stockhohn  in  1688,  and  died  in  London 
in  1772.  He  was  a  person  of  great  intel- 
lectual attainments,  a  member  of  several 
of  the  learned  societies  of  Europe,  and  the 
author  of  very  voluminous  philosophical 
treatises.  In  1745  he  separated  himself 
from  all  secular  pursuits,  relinquished  his 
official  labours  in  the  Swedish  State,  and 
commenced  the  career  which  led  to  a  re- 
ligious movement.  In  that  year,  and  thence- 
forth, he  was  favoured,  he  reports,  with 
continual  communications  from  the  spiri- 
tual world,  being  oftentimes  admitted  into 
heaven  itself,  and  there  indulged  with 
splendid  visions  of  angelic  glory  and  felicity. 


T26 


SWEDENBOEGIANS 


The  power  was  given  him  to  converse  with 
these  celestial  residents  ;  and  from  their 
revelations,  sometimes  made  directly  to 
himself  and  sometimes  gathered  by  him 
from  the  course  of  their  deliberations,  he 
obtained  the  most  important  of  his  doc- 
trines. In  a  letter  to  a  friend  he  asserts 
that  the  Lord  had  opened  his  sight  in  the 
year  1745,  and  given  him  to  speak  with 
angels  and  spirits,  and  that  he  published 
what  was  thus  revealed  to  him  concerning 
heaven  and  hell,  the  state  of  man  after 
death,  true  Divine  worship,  and  other  things 
of  the  highest  importance,  conducive  to  sal- 
vation and  wisdom. 

The  general  result  of  these  communica- 
tions was  to  convince  the  baron  that  the 
sacred  writings  have  two  senses — one  their 
natural,  the  other  their  spiritual,  sense  ;  the 
latter  of  which  it  was  his  high  commission 
to  unfold.  The  natural  sense  is  that  which 
is  alone  received  by  other  Christian  Churches 
— the  words  of  Scripture  being  understood 
to  have  the  same  signification  (and  no  other) 
which  they  bear  in  ordinary  human  inter- 
course ;  the  spiritual  sense  is  that  which, 
in  the  judgment  of  the  New  Church,  is 
concealed  witliin  the  natural  sense  of  these 
same  words,  each  word  or  phrase  possessing 
in  addition  to  its  ordinary  meaning,  an 
interior  significance  corresponding  with  some 
spiritual  truth. 

The  principal  tenets  he  deduced  from 
this  interior  meaning  of  the  Holy  Word, 
and  which  his  followers  still  maintain,  are 
these  :  That  the  last  judgment  has  al- 
ready been  accomplished  (viz.  in  1757) ; 
that  the  former  "heaven  and  earth"  are 
passed  away;  that  the  "New  Jerusalem," 
mentioned  in  the  Apocalypse,  has  aheady 
descended,  in  the  form  of  the  "  New 
Church  " ;  and  that,  consequently,  the  se- 
cond advent  of  the  Lord  has  even  now 
been  realized,  in  a  spiritual  sense,  by  the 
exhibition  of  his  power  and  glory  in  the 
New  Church  thus  established. 

The  usual  doctrine  of  the  Trinity  is  not 
received;  the  belief  of  the  New  Church 
being,  "  that  the  Father,  Son,  and  Holy 
Spirit  are  one  in  the  person  of  our  Lord 
Jesus  Christ,  comparatively  as  soul,  body, 
and  operative  energy  are  one  in  every 
individual  man." 

The  New  Church  also  rejects  the  doc- 
trine of  justification  by  faith  alone,  and 
the  imputed  righteousness  of  Christ :  sal- 
vation cannot  be  obtained  except  by  the 
combination  of  good  works  with  faith.  "  To 
fear  God,  and  to  work  righteousness,  is  to 
have  charity;  and  whoever  has  charity, 
whatever  his  religious  sentiments  may  be, 
will  be  saved." 

The  resurrection  will  not  be  that  of  the 
material  body,  but  of  a  spiritual  body  (which 


SYLLABUS 

indeed  St.  Paul  says  expressly  in  1  Cor. 
XV.).  But  (quite  contrary  to  St.  Paul)  tliis 
will  hot  immediately  pass  into  a  final  state 
of  being,  but  be  subjected  to  a  kind  of 
purgatory,  where  those  who  are  interiorly 
good  will  receive  truth  corresponding  with 
their  state  of  goodness,  and  thus  be  fitted 
for  heaven :  while  those  who  are  interiorly 
evil  wiU  reject  aU  truth,  and  thus  be  among 
the  lost. 

The  sacraments  of  baptism  and  the  Lord's 
supper  are  administered  in  the  New  Church. 
The  former  is  believed  to  be  "  a  sign  and  a 
medium,  attended  with  a  Divine  influence  of 
introduction  into  the  Lord's  Church ;  and  it 
means  that  the  Lord  will  purify  our  minds 
from  wicked  desires  and  bad  thoughts,  if 
we  are  obedient  to  his  Holy  word."  "riie 
latter  is  believed  to  be  "  a  sign  and  a  me- 
dium, attended  with  a  Divine  influence,  for 
introducing  the  Lord's  true  children,  as  to 
their  spirits,  into  heaven ;  and  it  means  that 
the  Lord  feeds  their  souls  with  His  Divine 
goodness  and  truth." 

The  mode  of  worship  adopted  by  the 
followers  of  Swedenborg  resembles  in  its 
general  form  that  of  most  other  Christian 
bodies  ;  the  distribution  of  subjects  in  their 
liturgy,  and  the  composition  of  their  hymns 
and  prayers,  being,  of  course,  special ;  biit 
no  particular  form  is  considered  to  be 
binding  on  each  society. 

The  general  affairs  of  the  New  Church 
(which  is  the  name  assumed  by  the  Sweden- 
borgian  sect)  are  managed  by  a  conference, 
which  meets  yearly,  composed  of  ministers 
and  laymen  in  conjunction ;  the  proportion 
of  the  latter  being  determined  by  the  size 
of  the  respective  congregations  which  they 
represent :  a  society  of  from  12  to  50  mem- 
bers sending  one  representative,  and  socie- 
ties of  from  50  to  100  members,  and  those 
of  upwards  of  100  members  sending  each 
two  and  three  representatives  respectively. 
There  is  nothing,  however,  in  Swedenborg's 
writings  to  sanction  any  particular  form  of 
Church  government.  —  Registrar-  OeneraVs 
Report;  Hindmarsh's  New  Christian  Re- 
ligion. 

In  England,  as  in  Germany,  a  few  clergy- 
men and  many  laymen,  have  adopted  many 
of  Swedenborg's  ideas,  without  separating 
from  the  Church.  The  sect  of  the  New 
Church  numbered  in  1881  58  societies, 
chiefly  in  London,  Lancashire,  and  York- 
shire, with  4,098  registered  members  above 
twenty  years  of  age.  In  Canada  and  the 
United  States  they  number  80  societies,  and 
about  5,000  members. 

SYLLABUS.  The  name  given  to  the 
summary  of  (Protestant)  errors  anathe- 
matised by  the  Vatican  Council  in  1865, 
and  perhaps  some  others  (See  Council  of 
Trent).     [G.] 


SYIMBOL 

SYMBOL,  or  SYMBOLUM.  A  title 
anciently  given  to  the  Apostles'  Creed, 
and  for  which  several  reasons  have  been 
assigned.  Two  of  these  have  an  appear- 
ance of  probability,  viz.  that  (1)  which 
derives  it  from  Greek  words  (cru/ijSdXoc,  from 
(Tvv  and  ^dXXoj),  signifying  a  throwing  or 
editing  together,  there  being  a  tradition  that 
the  apostles  each  contributed  an  article  to 
form  the  creed ;  and  (2)  that  this  creed  was 
used  in  times  of  persecution  as  a  watchword 
or  mark  whereby  Christians  (like  soldiei's 
in  the  army)  were  distinguished  from  all 
others.  This  latter  is  the  sense  given  in  the 
short  catechism  of  Edward  VI.,  1552,  where 
we  read,  "  M.  "Why  is  this  abridgment  of 
the  faith  termed  a  symbol  ?  S.  A  symbol 
is,  as  much  as  to  say,  a  sign,  mark,  privy 
token,  or  watchword,  whereby  the  soldiers 
of  the  same  camp  are  known  from  their 
enemies.  For  this  reason  the  abridgment  of 
the  faith,  whereby  the  Christians  are  known 
from  them  that  are  no  Christians,  is  rightly 
named  a  symbol."  And  there  can  be  little 
doubt  that  this  is  the  true  interpretation  of 
the  term.  The  former  explanation  rests 
upon  a  mere  legend  which  was  probably 
invented  to  account  for  the  name  of  the 
creed. 

The  term  symbol,  importing  an  emblem 
or  sensible  representation,  is  also  applied 
in  the  holy  Eucharist  to  the  sacred  elements, 
which  there  set  forth  the  body  and  blood  of 
Christ  (See  also  Emhlem). 

SYMPHONY  (<Tvii(j)a>vla).  A  consonance 
or  harmony  of  sounds.  In  music  technically, 
a  composition  for  an  orchestra,  consisting 
of  certain  movements,  generally  four.  But 
the  term  in  church  music  is  often  applied 
to  short  introductory  movements  on  the 
organ,  before  anthems  and  other  pieces ; 
also  to  any  portion  performed  by  the  in- 
strument without  the  voices,  including 
preludes,  interludes,  and  postludes,  i.e. 
strains  he/ore,  in  the  midst,  and  at  the  end 
of  psalmody,  and  other  church  music. 

SYNOD.  This  is  a  meeting  of  ecclesi- 
astical persons  for  the  purposes  of  religion, 
and  it  comprehends  the  provincial  synod  or 
■convocation  of  every  metropolitan,  and  the 
diocesan  of  every  bishop  within  their  limits. 
These  are  not  ofThe  same  authority  as 
general  councils,  nor  do  their  canons  oblige 
the  whole  Christian  Church,  nor  indeed  any 
body  in  England  at  present  (See  Convoca- 
tions ;  Councils). 

SYNOD ALS  and  SYNODATICUM,  by 
the  name,  have  a  plain  relation  to  the 
holding  of  synods ;  but  there  being  no 
reason  why  the  clergy  should  pay  for  their 
attending  the  bishop  in  synod,  pursuant 
to  his  own  citation,  nor  any  footsteps  to 
be  found  of  such  a  payment  by  reason  of 
the  holding  of  synods,  the  name  is  sup- 


TABEENAOLES 


727 


posed  to  have  grown  from  this  duty  being 
usually  paid  by  the  clergy  when  they 
came  to  the  synod.  And  this  in  all  pro- 
bability is  the  same  which  was  anciently 
called  cathedraticum,  as  paid  by  the  pa- 
rochial clergy  in  honour  to  the  episcopal 
chair,  and  in  token  of  subjection  and  obe- 
dience thereto.  So  it  stands  in  the  body 
of  the  canon  law,  "  No  bishop  shall  de- 
mand anything  of  the  churches  but  the 
honour  of  the  cathedraticum,  that  is,  two 
shillings  "  ("  at  the  most,"  saith  the  Gloss, 
for  sometimes  less  is  given).  And  the 
duty  which  we  call  synodals  is  generally 
such  a  small  payment,  which  payment  was 
reserved  by  the  bishop  upon  settling  the 
revenues  of  the  respective  churches  on  the 
incumbents ;  whereas  formerly  those  reve- 
nues were  paid  to  the  bishop,  who  had  a 
right  to  part  of  them  for  his  own  use,  and 
a  right  to  apply  and  distribute  the  rest  to 
such  uses  and  in  such  proportions  as  the 
laws  of  the  Church  directed. — Gibson. 

Synodals  are  due  of  common  right  to 
the  bishop  only,  so  that,  if  they  be  claimed 
or  demanded  by  the  archdeacon,  or  dean 
and  chapter,  or  any  other  person  or  per- 
sons, it  must  be  on  the  foot  of  composition 
or  prescription. — Id. 

And  if  they  be  denied  where  due,  they 
are  recoverable  in  the  spiritual  court. 
And,  in  the  time  of  Archbishop  Whitgift, 
they  were  declared  upon  a  full  hearing  to  be 
spiritual  profits,  and  as  such  to  belong  to  the 
keeper  of  the  spiritual  see  vacant.^ — Id. 

Constitutions  made  in  the  provincial  or 
diocesan  synods  were  also  sometimes  called 
synodals,  and  were  in  many  cases  required 
to  be  published  in  the  parish  churches :  in 
this  sense  the  word  frequently  occurs  in 
the  ancient  directories. — Gibb.  Hist.  Excheq. 
E.  4 ;  Hallam's  Constit.  Eist.  iii.  236. 


TABERNACLE  (Heb.  JStf't?,  ^gV«; 
Gk.  a-KTjvij;  Lat.  tdbernaculum).  Among 
the  Hebrews,  a  kind  of  building,  in  the  form 
of  a  tent,  set  up  by  the  express  command 
of  God,  for  the  performance  of  rehgious 
worship,  sacrifices,  &c.  (Exod.  xxvi.,  xxvii.). 

TABERNACLES,  FEAST  OP.  A 
solemn  festival  of  the  Hebrews,  observed 
after  harvest,  on  the  fifteenth  day  of  the 
month  Tisri,  instituted  to  commemorate  the 
goodness  of  God,  who  protected  the  Israelites 
in  the  wilderness,  and  made  them  dwell  in 
booths  when  they  came  out  of  Egypt  (See 
Diet.  Bible).  The  pyx,  or  box  in  which  "the 
reserved  host  is  placed  on  Romish  altars,  is 
called  in  the  Missal  the  Tabernacle. 


728 


TABLE 


TABLE,  HOLY  (See  Altar). 

TALMUD  (Signifying  doctrine).  A 
collection  of  the  doctrines  of  the  religion 
and  morality  of  the  Jews.  The  history  of 
the  Talmud  is  the  history  of  the  people  since 
the  days  of  Ezra  to  that  of  the  final  com- 
pletion of  Gemara,  at  the  close  of  the  6th 
century  of  the  Christian  a-ra.  It  consists  of 
two  parts:  1.  The  Misna,  of  which  temi 
various  derivations  have  been  given,  the 
most  probahle  being  that  supplied  by  the 
Kabbinical  lexicon,  Shulchan  Aruch,  re- 
ferring the  name  to  "  Sheni,"  "  second  " ;  the 

Mishna  or  oral  law  nElPPDETI  beino  second  to 
the  written  law  an^JBTl,  and  which  they 
pretend  was  delivered  to  Moses  on  the 
mount,  and  transmitted  from  him  to  the 
members  of  the  Sanhedrim.  2.  The  Oemara 
(perfection,  or  completion),  which  is  the 
commentary.  The  history  of  this  work  is 
as  follows :  — 

"  Judah  the  Holy,"  the  first  compiler,  had 
no  sooner  completed  the  Misna,  but  two 
Rabbis,  Chaia  and  Hoshaia,  published  extra 
traditions ;  a  collection  of  which  was  made 
under  thetitle  of  Baraitha  or  Extravagantes, 
and  inserted  with  the  Misna,  in  order  to 
compose  one  and  the  same  body  of  law. 

In  this  two  considerable  faults  were 
observed :  one,  that  it  was  very  confused, 
the  other  (which  rendered  this  body  of 
canon  law  almost  useless),  that  it  was  too 
short,  and  resolved  hut  a  small  part  of  the 
doubtful  cases  and  questions  that  began  to 
be  agitated  among  the  Jews. 

To  remedy  these  inconveniences,  Jo- 
chanan,  with  the  assistance  of  Bab  and 
Samuel,  two  disciples  of  "  Jndah  the  Holy," 
wrote  a  commentary.  This  is  called  the 
Talmud  of  Jerusalem.  The  Jews  are  not 
agreed  about  the  time  that  this  part  of 
the  Oemara  was  made.  Some  believe  it 
was  two  hundred  years  after  the  destruction 
of  Jerusalem ;  others  reckon  but  a  hundred 
and  fifty  ;  and  maintain  that  Rah  and 
Samuel,  quitting  Judfea,  went  to  Babylon,  in 
the  two  hundred  and  nineteenth  year  of 
the  Christian  ajra.  However,  these  are 
the  heads  of  the  second  order  of  doctors, 
called  Gemarists,  because  they  composed  the 
Gemara. 

There  was  also  a  defect  in  the  Jerusalem 
Talmud,  for  it  contained  the  opinions  of  but 
a  small  number  of  doctors.  For  this  reason 
the  Gemarists,  or  commentators,  began  a  new 
explication  of  th|^aditions.  Rabbi  Asa, 
who  kept  a  school  ajt  Sora,  near  Babylon, 
where  he  taught  forty  years,  produced  a 
-commentary  upon  Judah's  Misna.  He  did 
not  finish  it ;  but  his  sons  and  scholars  put 
the  last  hand  to  it.  This  is  called  the 
Gemara,  or  Talmud,  of  Babylon,  which  is 
preferred  before  that  of  Jerusalem.  It  is  a 
very  large  collection,  containing  the  tradi- 


TARGUM 

tions,  the  canon  law  of  the  Jews,  and  all 
the  questions  relating  to  the  Law.  But  so 
much  comparatively  modern  matter  has 
been  interpolated  in  it  beyond  doubt,  that 
the  whole  of  it,  as  it  now  exists,  is  tainted 
with  modernism  to  an  indefinite  extent,  so 
that  it  is  of  no  real  authority  and  very  little 
evidential  value  as  to  ancient  usages. 

In  these  two  Talmuds  is  contained  the 
whole  of  the  Jewish  religion  as  it  is  now 
possessed  by  that  people,  who  esteem  it 
equal  with  the  law  of  God.  Some  Chris- 
tians set  a  great  value  upon  it,  whilst  others 
condemn  it  altogether,  but  a  third  party 
ob.«erve  a  just  medium  between  these  opposite 
opinions. 

Though  the  Talmud  was  received  with 
general  applause  by  the  Jews,  yet  there 
started  up  a  new  order  of  doctors,  who 
shook  its  authority  by  their  doubts.  These 
were  called  Sebarim,  or  opiniative  doctors, 
and  were  looked  upon  by  the  Jews  as  so 
many  sceptics,  because  they  disputed  with- 
out coming  to  a  determination  upon  any- 
thins.  [An  interesting  and  learned  account 
of  the  Talmud  may  be  read  in  the  Remains 
of  the  late  Emanuel  Deutsch.] 

TARGUM  (DUnPI,  from  Dnn).  So  the 
Jews  call  the  Cbaldee  paraphrases,  or  exposi- 
tions, of  the  Old  Testament  in  the  Aramaic 
language  ;  for  the  Jewish  doctors,  in  order 
to  make  the  people  understand  the  text  of 
the  Holy  Scripture  (after  the  captivity), 
which  was  read  in  Hebrew  in  their  syna- 
gogues, were  forced  to  explain  the  law 
to  them  in  a  language  they  understood ; 
and  this  was  the  Aramaic,  or  that  used  in 
Assyria. 

The  Targums  that  are  now  remaining 
were  composed  by  different  persons,  u^xin 
different  parts  of  Scripture,  and  are  in 
number  eight. 

1.  The  Targum  of  Onkelos  upon  the  five 
books  of  Moses. 

2.  The  Targum  of  Jonathan  Ben  Uzziel, 
upon  the  Prophets,  that  is,  upon  Joshua, 
Judges,  the  two  Books  of  Samuel,  the  two 
Books  of  Kings,  Isaiah,  Jeremiah,  Ezekiel, 
and  the  twelve  Minor  Prophets. 

3.  The  Targum  ascribed  to  Jonathan  Ben 
Uzziel,  upon  the  Law. 

4.  The  Jerusalem  Targum,  upon  the  Law. 

5.  The  Targum  on  the  five  lesser  books, 
called  the  Megilloth,  that  is,  Ruth,  Esther, 
Ecclesiastes,  the  Song  of  Solomon,  and  the 
Lamentations  of  Jeremiah. 

6.  The  second  Targum  upon  Esther. 

7.  The  Targum  of  Joseph  the  Blind, 
upon  the  Book  of  Job,  the  Psalms,  and  the 
Proverbs. 

8.  The  Targum  upon  the  First  and  Se- 
cond Books  of  Chronicles. 

Upon  Ezra  and  Nehemiah,  there  is  no 
Targum,  nor  any  upon  Daniel  in  Chaldee. 


TE  DEUM  LAUDAMUS 

Indeed,  a  great  part  of  Daniel  and  Ezra  is 
written  originally  in  Chaldee ;  and  therefore 
there  was  no  need  of  a  Chaldee  paraphrase 
upon  them :  but  Nehemiah  is  written  wholly 
in  the  Hebrew  tongue.and  no  doubt  anciently 
there  were  Chaldee  paraphrases  upon  all  the 
Hebrew  parts  of  those  books,  though  they 
are  now  lost.  Upon  Daniel  there  is  a 
Persian  Targum,  wiittea  seemingly  in  the 
twelfth  century. 

For  a  full  account  of  the  Targum,  see 
Smith's  Diet.  Bible,  s.  v.  "  Versions."  Also 
article  in"  Church  Quarterly  Review,"  April 
1884. 

TE     DEUM     LAUDAMUS      ("We 
praise  Thee,  0  God,"  or  "  as  God  ").     This 
hymn  of  praise  has  been  referred  to  several 
different  authors.      Some  have  ascribed  it 
to  Ambrose  and  Augustine  ("  Saynt  Austyn 
and  Saynt  Ambrose  madefyrstthisHympne" 
(Mirrour  of  our  Ladye,  fol.  Ixii.)  ;  others  to 
Ambrose  alone  ;  others,  again,  to  Abondius, 
Nicetius,    bishop  of  Triers,  or    Hilary  of 
Poictiers.     In  truth,  it  seems  that  there  is 
no  way  of  determining  exactly  who  was  the 
author  of  this   hymn.    Archbishop   Usher 
found  it  ascribed  to  Nicetius,  in  a  very  an- 
cient Galilean  Psalter,  and  the  Benedictine 
editors  of  the  works  of  Hilary  of  Poictiers 
cite   a  fragment  of  a  manuscript  epistle  of 
Abbo  Floriacensis,  in  which  Hilary  is  un- 
hesitatingly sfxiken  of  as  its  author  ;  but 
Abbo  lived  five  or  six  centuries  after  that 
prelate,   and   therefore   such   a  tradition   is 
most  doubtful.     In  the  Alexandrine  MS.  of 
the  Scriptures  (Brit.   Museum)  there   is  a 
morning  hymn  with  several  verses  from  or 
similar  to  the  Te  Deum.     Some  reasons  ap- 
pear to  justify  the  opinion  that  the  Te  Deum 
was  composed  in  the  Galilean  Church,  from 
which  source  we  also  derive  the  creed  bearing 
the  name  of  Athanasius  (See  Creed).    The 
most  ancient  allusions  to  its  existence  are 
found  in  the   Rule  of  Ciesarius,  bishop  of 
Aries,  c.  a.d.  527,  and  in  that  of  his   suc- 
cessor Aurelian.     It   has   been  judged    by 
some  from   this,  that  the  Te  Deum  may 
have  been  composed  by  some  member  of  the 
■celebrated  monastery  of  Lerins,  which  was 
not  far  from  Aries ;  or  perhaps  by  Hilary  of 
Aries,  to  whom  has  been  ascribed,  but  on  no 
good  ground,  the  composition  of  the  Athana- 
sian  Creed  in  the  fifth  century  (See  Creed, 
Athanasian).    But  its  origin  was  earlier,  and 
the  most  likely  conclusion  to  come  to  is, 
that  while  in  its  present  form  it  is  a  com- 
position of  the  fourth  or  fifth  centuries,  it 
represents   a  still  more  ancient  hymn,   of 
which  traces  are  to  be  found  in  St.  Cyprian 
and    the    Alexandrine  MS. — Did.    Christ. 
Ant.  1949;   Blunt's  Annot.   P.   B.\.  10; 
Herman   Daniel,    Thes.  Hymnal,   ii.    279 ; 
Maskell's  Mon.  Bit.  Heel.  Ang.  iii.  14. 
In  the  office  of  matins  this  hymn  occupies 


TEMPLARS 


729 


the  same  place  as  it  always  has  done,  namely, 
after  the  reading  of  Scripture.  The  ancient 
offices  of  the  English  Church  gave  this 
hymn  the  title  of  the  "  Psalm  Te  Deum," 
or  the  "  Song  of  Ambrose  and  Augustine," 
indifferently.  As  used  in  this  place,  it  maj^ 
be  considered  as  a  responsory  psalm,  since  it 
follows  a  lesson ;  and  here  the  practice  of 
the  Church  of  England  resembles  that 
directed  by  the  Council  of  Laodicea,  which 
decreed  that  the  psalms  and  lessons  should 
be  read  alternately. 

In  the  Roman  office  it  is  only  used  on 
Sundays  and  certain  festivals ;  but  even  on 
these  omitted  at  certain  seasons  of  the  year. 
In  the  Church  of  England  it  is  prescribed 
for  daily  use,  but  the  Benedicite  may  be 
substituted  for  it.     [H.] 

TEMPERANCE  (See  Societies,  Church). 
TEMPLARS,  TEMPLBRS,  or 
KNIGHTS  OP  THE  TEMPLE.  A  mili- 
tary religious  order  instituted  at  Jerusalem, 
in  the  beginning  of  the  twelfth  century,  for 
the  defence  of  the  holy  sepulchre,  and  the 
protection  of  Christian  pilgrims.  They 
were  first  called  the  Poor  of  the  Holy  City, 
and  afterwards  Templars,  because  their  first 
dwelling,  given  them  by  Baldwin  II.,  King 
of  Jerusalem,  was  near  the  Temple.  The 
order  was  founded  in  1118  by  seven  French 
knights,  of  whom  the  chief  was  Hugh,  sur- 
named  des  Payens ;  and  the  principal  articles 
of  their  rule  were,  that  they  should  attend 
all  the  holy  offices  by  day  and  night ;  or 
that,  when  their  military  duties  should 
prevent  this,  thej"-  should  supply  it  by  a 
certain  number  of  Paternosters;  that  they 
should  abstain  from  flesh  four  days  in  the 
week,  and  on  Friday  from  eggs  and  milk ; 
that  each  knight  might  have  three  horses 
and  one  squire,  and  that  they  should  neither 
hunt  nor  hawk.  In  1127,  Hugh  and  some  of 
the  brethren  returned  to  Europe,  and  at  the 
Council  of  Troyes,  1128,  held  under  a  Papal 
legate,  the  order  was  formally  established 
and  received  a  code  of  statutes  drawn  up 
under  the  direction  of  St.  Bernard.  After 
this  it  rapidly  increased,  and  after  the  fall 
of  Jerusalem  in  1187,  the  Templars  spread 
themselves  through  Germany,  and  other 
countries  of  Europe,  to  which  they  were 
invited  by  the  liberality  of  the  Christians. 
In  every  nation  they  had  a  particular 
governor,  called  Master  of  the  Temple,  or  of 
the  Militia  of  the  Temple.  Their  grand- 
master had  his  resideni;&  at  Paris.  The 
order  of  Templars  flourished  for  nearly  two 
centuries,  and  acquired,  by  the  valour  of  its 
knights,  immense  riches,  and  an  eminent 
degree  of  military  renovm.  But  as  their 
prosperity  increased,  their  virtue  declined ; 
and  they  became  unpopular  on  account  of 
their  arrogance.  King  Philip  the  Fair  of 
France,  moved  partly  by  cupidity,  partly  by 


730 


TEMPLE 


jealousy,  resolved  on  the  suppression  of  the 
order.  The  most  monstrous  and  incredible 
charges  of  vice  and  blasphemy  were  levelled 
at  them,  but  never  thoroughly  sifted.  The 
pope  however  (Clement  V)  aided  the  king 
in  his  purpose,  and  the  order  was  dissolved 
not  only  m  France  but  in  other  countries, 
through  papal  influence,  in  1312. 

TEMPLE.  L  In  the  Bible,  this  title 
generally  refers  to  that  house  of  prayer 
which  Solomon  built  in  Jerusalem,  for  the 
honour  and  worship  of  Grod.  The  name  of 
temple  is  now  properly  used  for  any  church 
or  place  of  worship  set  apart  for  the  service 
of  Almighty  God.  Thus  the  services  of  the 
Church  are  frequently  introduced  by  the 
words,  "The  Lord  is  in  His  holy  temple; 
let  all  the  earth  keep  silence  before  Him." 
Here,  by  the  word  "  temple,"  allusion  is 
made  to  the  church  in  which  we  have  met 
together  to  offer  our  prayers  and  praises  to 
the  Most  High. 

IL  The  church  called  the  Temple  Church 
in  London  was  built  by  the  Knights- 
Templars  in  1185  ;  and  the  circular  vestibule 
was  built  after  the  fashion  of  the  church  of 
the  Holy  Sepulchre  at  Jerusalem :  as  also  the 
church  of  the  Holy  Sepulchre  at  Cambridge, 
and  at  Northampton  and  Little  Maple- 
stead.     [H.] 

TERRIEE.  By  Canon  87,  "  the  arch- 
bishops and  all  bishops  within  their  several 
dioceses  shall  procure  (as  much  as  in  them 
lies)  a  true  note  and  terrier  of  all  the  glebes, 
lands,  meadows,  gardens,  orchards,  houses, 
stocks,  implements,  tenements,  and  portions 
of  tithes  lying  out  of  their  parishes,  which 
belong  to  any  parsonage,  vicarage,  or  rural 
prebend,  to  be  taken  by  the  view  of  honest 
men  in  every  parish,  by  the  appointment  of 
the  bishop,  whereof  the  minister  to  be  one ; 
and  to  be  laid  up  in  the  bishop's  registry, 
there  to  be  for  a  perpetual  memory  thereof. 
It  may  be  convenient  also  to  have  a  copy  of 
the  same  exempHfied,  to  be  kept  in  the 
church  chest." 

These  terriers  are  of  greater  authority  in 
the  ecclesiastical  courts  than  they  arc  in  the 
temporal;  for  the  ecclesiastical  courts  are 
not  allowed  to  be  courts  of  record ;  and  yet 
even  in  the  temporal  courts  these  terriers  are 
of  some  weight,  when  duly  attested  by  the 
registrar. 

Especially  if  they  be  signed,  not  only  by 
the  parson  and  churchwardens,  but  also  by 
the  substantial  inhabitants ;  but  if  they  be 
signed  by  the  parson  only,  they  can  be  no 
evidence  for  him  ;  so  neither  (as  it  seemeth) 
if  they  be  signed  only  by  the  parson  and 
churchwardens,  if  the  churchwardens  are  of 
Ms  nomination.  But  in  all  cases  they  are 
certainly  strong  evidence  against  the  parson 
(See  Burn,  Eccl.  Law,  under  this  head,  for 
the  form  of  a  terrier,  which  is  given  at  great 


TEESANCTUS 

length.  It  is,  however,  merely  an  inventory 
of  the  matters  enumerated  in  the  above- 
quoted  canon). 

TEESANCTUS.  The  Latin  title  of  the 
hymn  in  the  liturgy,  beginning  "With 
Angels  and  Archangels,"  &c.  This  is. 
probably  the  most  ancient  and  universally 
received  of  all  Christian  songs  of  praise.  Its 
position  in  the  established  liturgies  has 
always  been  (as  in  the  Prayer  Book)  a  little 
antecedent  to  the  prayer  of  consecration ; 
and  the  hymn  itself  does  not  appear  in  any 
other  office  than  that  of  the  Communion. 
The  antiquity  of  the  Tersanctus,  and  its 
prevalence  in  the  liturgies  of  the  Eastern 
and  Western  Churches,  naturally  lead  to 
the  conclusion  that  it  was  derived  from  the 
apostolic  age,  if  not  from  the  apostles  them- 
selves. It  is  remarked  by  Palmer,  that  no 
liturgy  can  be  traced  to  antiquity,  in  which 
the  people  did  not  unite  with  the  invisible 
host  of  heaven  in  chanting  these  sublime 
praises  of  the  Most  High  God.  From  the 
testimony  of  Chrysostom  (St.  Chrys.,  Horn. 
xviii.  in  2  Oor.),  and  Cyril  of  Jerusalem 
(Catech.  Myst.  5,  n.  5),  we  find  that  the 
seraphic  hymn  was  used  in  the  liturgy  of 
Antioch  and  Jerusalem  in  the  fourth  century. 
With  it  may  be  compared  the  orthodox  and 
Monophysite  thanksgivings  of  the  litui^  of 
St.  James  (Eenaudot,  Liturg.  Orient,  t.  ii. 
p.  31).  The  Apostolical  Constitutions  (viii. 
c.  12)  enable  us  to  carry  it  back  to  the 
third  century  in  the  East.  It  is  also  spoken 
of  by  Gregory  Nyssen,  Cyril  of  Alexandria, 
Origen,  Hilary  of  Poiotiers,  Isidore,  and 
other  iFathers,  as  having  formed  a  part  of 
the  liturgy.  In  the  liturgy  of  Milan  it  has 
been  used  from  time  immemorial,  under  the 
name  of  Trisagion ;  in  Africa  we  learn  from 
TertuUian,  that  it  was  customarily  used  in 
the  second  century  {De  Orat.  c.  iii.).  The 
preface  ends  just  before  the  words  "  Holy, 
holy,  holy : "  and  in  this  hymn,  but  not 
before,  the  clerks  and  the  people  should 
audibly  join  their  voices  with  the  priest.  In 
all  the  ancient  liturgies,  both  of  the  East 
and  of  the  West,  the  saying  of  the  Sanctus 
is  given  to  the  choir  and  people.  The  cele- 
brant having  recited  the  preface  or  intro- 
duction, the  Triumphal  Hymn,  as  the 
liturgies  of  St.  Basil  and  St.  Chrysostom 
call  it,  is  taken  up  by  the  whole  body  of  the 
worshippers,  who,  as  kings  and  priests  unto 
God,  join  in  that  solemn  act  of  adoration  of 
the  ever-blessed  Trinity  (Eenaudot,  Liturg. 
Orient,  i.  516;  Goar,  Rit.  Orsec.  p.  166). 
The  joining  in  at  "  Therefore  with  angels," 
&c.,  as  is  the  case  in  some  English  churches, 
never  was  the  custom  of  the  primitive 
Church,  and  could  not  have  been  intended 
by  tho.'ie  who  revised  our  liturgy,  nor  is  it 
warranted  by  the  nature  of  the  preface 
itself.    Nevertheless  it  is  implied  by  the 


TESTAMENT 

rubric  as  it  at  present  stands.  In  the 
Prayer  Books  of  1549  and  1552  the  Sanctus 
was  printed  in  a  separate  paragraph,  thus 
marking  the  ancient  custom  (See  Preface). 
— Bingham,  xv.  iii.  10;  Palmer's  Orig. 
Liturg.  ii.  128;  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  ii. 
183.     [H.] 

TESTAMENT,  THE  OLD  AND  NEW 
{bia6r)Kr),  testamentum.  The  Hebrew  word 
in  the  Old  Testament  which  is  generally 
translated  Siadtj/oj  in  the  LXX.  is  n'13). 
T.  The  title  of  the  Old  Testament  is  given 
to  those  books  which  the  Jewish  Church 
received  as  sacred  and  inspired,  and  which, 
on  this  testimony,  are  accepted  as  such  by 
the  Christian  Church ;  for  "  to  the  Jews  were 
committed  the  oracles  of  God"  (Rom.  iii.  2). 
"H  TToXaia  AiadrjKri, "  the  old  dispensation,"  is 
used  for  the  books  of  Moses  containing  that 
dispensation  by  St.  Paul  (2  Cor.  iii.  14); 
and  the  sense,  the  old  dispensation,  occurs 
Pom.  ix.  4;  Eph.  ii.  10;  Heb.  lx.  15,  20: 
viii.  7,  9 :  ix.  5.  Adopting  one  of  the 
meanings  of  SiadfiKrj,  a  will  or  covenant,  Ter- 
tullian  uses  the  phrase  Vetus  Testamentum 
(adv.  Marc.  iv.  1, 2),  which  has  since  become 
the  common  expression ;  and  has  been  thus 
explained :  "  A  will  first  becomes  valuable 
after  the  death  of  the  testator ;  so  after  the 
death  of  Christ,  the  mysteries  of  the  Old 
Testament  being  fulfilled  became  intelligible 
and  valuable"  (Lactantius,  Inst.  14,  20). 
According  to  the  old  classification  the  books 
of  the  Old  Testament  were  divided  into  the 
Law,  the  Prophets,  the  "  SacredWritings  " 
(See  Hagiograplia).  Our  Lord  speaks  of  "  the 
Law,  the  Prophets,  and  the  Psalms  " ;  the 
Hagiographa  or  Sacred  Writings  being  often 
styled  the  "  Psalms,"  as  that  book  headed 
the  list.  But  in  other  places  the  Old 
Testament  was  divided  simply  into  the 
"  Law  and  the  Prophets,"  as  our  Lord  says 
"  Think  not  that  I  am  come  to  destroy 
the  law,  or,  the  prophets  "  (St.  Matt.  v.  17). 
And  this  was  the  common  division.  Thus 
St.  Augustine  says,  "The  Old  contains  the 
Law  and  the  Prophets,  the  New  the  Gospels 
and  the  Apostolic  Epistles.  Although  the 
Old  is  prior  in  point  of  time,  the  New  has 
the  precedence  in  intrinsic  value;  for  the 
Old  acts  the  part  of  herald  to  the  New" 
(De  Civ.  Dei,  xx.  4). 

II.  As  Tj  noKaxa  hiaBriio]  was  used  as  de- 
scriptive of  the  books  of  the  Old  Testament 
by  St.  Paul,  it  was  natural  that  ^  Kalvrj 
diaSriKYj  should  be  applied  to  the  new  dis- 
pensation. In  this  sense,  the  new  dis- 
fiensaiion,  the  word  occurs  in  St.  Matt, 
xxvi.  28,  and  the  parallel  passages  in  St. 
Matthew  and  St.  Luke :  in  1  Cor.  xi.  25 ; 
2  Cor.  iii.  6 ;  Heb.  vii.  22,  &c.  The  books 
of  the  New  Testament  collectively  are 
called  Tj  Ka'ivr]  ScadrjKr]  by  Origen  (de 
Princip.  iv.  1),  as  they  are  called  Novum 


TESTIMONIAL 


731 


Testamentum  by  Tertullian  (adv.  Marc. 
iv.  1). 

The  title  "New  Dispensation"  signifies 
the  book  which  contains  the  terms  of  the 
New  Dispensation,  upon  which  God  is  pleased 
to  offer  salvation  to  mankind,  through  the 
mediation  of  Jesus  Christ.  But  the  word 
Testament  seems  to  have  been  prefeiTcd, 
as  implying  that  the  Christian's  redemption 
is  sealed  to  Him  as  a  son  and  heir  of  God ; 
and  because  the  death  of  Christ  as  testa- 
tor is  related  at  large  and  applied  to  our 
benefit  (See  Oanon  of  Scripture  ;  Bible  ; 
Scripture).     fH.] 

TESTIMONI A  L.  A  testimonial  of  good 
conduct  from  his  college  or  from  three 
beneficed  clergymen,  required  of  every  one- 
that  seeks  to  be  admitted  into  holy  orders,, 
is  among  the  safeguards  which  the  Church 
has  appointed  for  the  purity  of  her  ministry. 
By  canon  33  the  bishop  is  forbidden  to 
admit  any  person  into  sacred  orders,  "except 
he  shall  then  exhibit  letters  testimonial  of 
his  good  life  and  conversation,  under  the 
seal  of  some  college  in  Cambridge  or  Oxford,, 
where  before  he  remained,  or  of  three  or 
four  grave  ministers,  together  with  the 
subscription  and  testimony  of  other  credible 
persons,  who  have  known  his  hfe  and 
behaviour  by  the  space  of  three  years 
next  before."  The  Act  of  13  Ehz.  c.  12,. 
enacts  that  "  None  shall  be  made  minister, 
unless  he  first  bring  to  the  bishop  of  that 
diocese,  from  men  known  to  the  bishop  to 
be  of  sound  religion,  a  testimonial  both  of 
his  honest  life,  and  of  his  professing  the 
doctrine  expressed  in  the  said  articles." 
The  testimonial  is  directed  to  the  bishop  to 
whom  application  is  made  for  orders,  and 
is  as  follows : 

"  Whereas  our  well-beloved  in  Christ,  A. 
B.,  hath  declared  to  us  his  intention  of 
offering  himself  as  candidate  for  the  sacred 
office  of  [a  deacon],  and  for  that  end  hath 
requested  of  us  letters  testimonial  of  his 
learning  and  good  behaviour ;  we,  therefore, 
whose  names  are  hereunto  subscribed,  do- 
testify  that  the  said  A.  B.,  having  been 
previously  kno-wn  to  us  for  the  space  of 
[three]  years  last  past,  hath  during  that 
time  lived  piously,  soberly,  and  honestly, 
and  diligently  applied  himself  to  his  stu- 
dies ;  nor  hath  he  at  any  time,  so  far  as  we- 
know  or  believe,  held,  written,  or  taught 
anything  contrary  to  the  doctrine  or  dis- 
cipline of  the  Church  of  England:  and 
moreover,  we  believe  him  in  our  con- 
sciences to  be  a  person  worthy  to  be 
admitted  to  the  sacred  order  of  [deacons]. 
In  -(vitness  whereof,"  &c. 

It  was  decided  in  Marshall  v.  Bishop  of 
Exeter,  3  H.  L.  17,  that  the  absence  of 
testimonials  from  one  bishop  to  another  is. 
not  sufficient  ground  for  refusing  institution 


732 


TEXT 


to  a  living.  The  Act  and  Canon  relate  to 
ordination  only,  and  naturally  do  not  require 
a  bishop's  certificate,  the  candidate  not  yet 
feeing  under  any  bishop.  The  bishop  may, 
however,  certify  that  the  persons  signing 
the  testimonial  are  known  to  him  as  persons 
of  credit  in  his  diocese,  as  the  ordaining 
bishop  might  not  know  them. 

TEXT.  The  letter  of  the  sacred 
Scriptures,  more  especially  in  the  original 
languages.  In  a  more  limited  sense,  the 
word  text  is  used  for  any  short  sentence 
-Gut  of  the  Sciipture,  quoted  in  proof  of  a 
dogmatic  position, — as  an  auctoritee,  as  it 
was  formerly  called, — or  taken  as  the 
subject  or  motto  of  a  discourse  from  the 
pulpit.     Thus  Chaucer  has — 

"  He  needeth  not  to  Bpeken  but  of  f;ame. 
And  let  av£tffritAS  in  Goddes  name 
To  preching,  and  to  scole  eke  of  clergie.** 

And  so  a  sermon  is  called  "  Kxpositio 
auctoritatis" 

The  custom  of  taking  a  text  for  a  sermon 
is  probably  coeval  with  that  of  preaching 
set  discourses ;  and  it  is  needless  to  remark, 
that  the  use  of  texts  as  authority  in 
doctrinal  points  is  of  the  very  essence  of 
true  theology,  and  was  ever  the  custom 
even  of  those  who,  professing  the  name  of 
Christians,  denied  the  truth  of  Christ. 
Even  the  most  abominable  and  shameless 
heretics  quoted  Scripture  for  their  worst 
tenets.  It  is  therefore  necessary  to  be  on 
the  guard  against  receiving  everything  for 
which  a  text  is  quoted,  remembering  that 
4he  "inspired  writings  are  an  inestimable 
treasure  to  mankind,  for  so  many  sentences, 
so  many  truths.  But  then  the  true  sense 
of  them  must  be  known ; "  which  it  often 
only  can  be  by  comparing  them  with  others, 
as  it  is  not  the  way  of  Scripture  to  intro- 
duce exceptions  and  qualifications  like  a 
CQodern  Act  of  Parliament,  but  to  deliver 
one  truth  strongly  at  one  time,  and  a  quali- 
fying one  at  another. 

TENEBRiE.  An  ancient  office  of  the 
-Church  of  England,  which  was  used  on 
Wednesday  in  Holy  Week  and  the  two  suc- 
iceeding  days.  The  ceremony  from  which  it 
derived  its  name  consisted  in  the  gradual 
extinction  of  lights  one  by  one  until  the 
church  was  left  in  darkness.     [H.] 

THANKSGIVING.  Giving  of  thanks 
is  an  essential  part  of  Divine  worship,  as 
St.  Paul  expressly  declares  to  St.  Timothy 
■(1  Tim.  ii.  1),  and  has  ever  formed  a  part 
-of  the  service  both  of  Jews  and  Christians. 
In  our  own  Book  of  Common  Prayer  there  are 
many  forms  of  thanksgiving,  particular  and 
general :  as  the  general  thanksgiving  (q.  v.), 
which  was  added  (being  compiled  by  Bishop 
Reynolds)  and  appointed  for  daily  use  at  the 
last  review ;  the  eucharistic  hymn,  always 
msed  in  the  Holy  Communion,  sometimes 


THEOLOGICAL  COLLEGES 

with  an  appropriate  preface,  and  introduced 
with  the  versicles, 

"  Let  us  give  thanks  unto  our  Lord  God. 

"  It  is  meet  and  right  so  to  do. 

"  It  is  very  meet,  right,  and  our  bounden 
dutj'',  that  we  should  at  all  times  and  in  all 
places  give  thanks,"  &c. ;  the  thanksgiving 
after  communion,  a  conspicuous  feature  in  all 
primitive  liturgies,  but  which  had  dropped 
out  of  the  mediaeval  service,  except  in  the 
form  of  a  private  prayer  of  the  celebrant : 
that  in  our  service  is  partly  taken  from 
Hermann's  Consultation,  but  greatly  re- 
seiTibles  the  corresponding  part  of  the  liturgy 
of  St.  James ;  the  thanksgiving  after  bap- 
tism, to  which,  in  the  revision  of  1661,  the 
Puritans  objected,  inasmuch  as  "  we  cannot 
say  in  faith  that  every  child  that  is  baptized 
is  regenerated  by  God's  Holy  Spirit;  at 
least  it  is  a  disputable  point":  the  bishops 
replying,  after  quoting  St.  John  iiL  and 
Acts  iii.  3,  that  "  Baptism  is  our  spiritual 
regeneration,"  and  "  by  it  is  received  remis- 
sion of  si'  'S  " — "  Seeing  that  God's  sacraments 
have  their  effects,  where  the  receiver  doth 
not  put  any  bar  against  them  (which  chil- 
dren cannot  do) ;  we  may  say  in  faith  of 
every  child  that  it  is  regenerated  by  God's 
Holy  Spiiit ;  and  the  denial  of  it  tends  to 
Anabaptism,  and  the  contempt  of  this  Holy 
Sacrament,  as  nothing  worthy  or  material 
whether  it  be  administered  to  children  or 
no"  (Cardwell.  Covf.  p.  356,  and  Mozley 
and  Bethell  on  Baptismal  Regeneration). 

There  are,  besides,  particular  thanks- 
givings appointed  for  deliverance  from 
drought,  rain,  famine,  war,  tumult,  and 
pestilence;  and  there  is  an  entire  service 
of  thanksgiving  for  women  after  childbirth 
(see  Cliurcliing  of  Women'),  and  certain 
days  on  which  we  commemorate  great 
deliverances  of  our  Church  and  nation, 
are  marked  also  with  a  solemn  service  of 
thanksgiving  (See  Forms  of  Frayer). 

THANKSGIVING,  THE  GENERAL. 
So  called  (1)  as  it  is  for  all  persons,  (2)  to 
distinguish  it  from  the  Special  Thanks- 
givings. Though  compiled  by  Bishop  Rey- 
nolds (see  Tlianksgiviny),  the  first  portion  of 
it  seems  to  be  borrowed  from  an  opening  of 
a  thanksgiving  composed  by  Queen  Elizabeth 
after  one  of  her  progresses,  and  which  is 
printed  (from  a  copy  in  the  State  Paper 
office)  in  the  "  Liturgies  of  Queen  Eliza- 
beth "  of  the  Parker  Society  (p.  667).  But 
it  is  most  probable  that  there  is  some  older 
prayer,  the  original  both  of  Queen  Eliza- 
beth's and  Bishop  Reynolds'. — Annot.  P.  B. 
There  is  no  authority  for  the  congregation 
saying  it  with  the  minister,  as  is  commonly 
the  cace  in  America.    [H.] 

THEOLOGICAL  COLLEGES.  Institu- 
tions founded  for  providing  special  instruc- 
tion and  training  for  those  who  are  preparing 


THEOLOGY 

for  ordination.  The  first  of  these  colleges 
was  that  of  St.  Bees,  founded  in  1816,  and 
intended  especially  for  those  who  had  not 
taken  a  University  degree.  In  1839  the 
Chichester  Theological  College  was  iastituted, 
and  in  the  next  year  that  of  Wells.  There 
are  now  Colleges  connected  with  the  Cathe- 
drals of  Lichfield,  Salisbury,  Gloucester, 
Lincoln,  Ely,  and  Truro,  while  others  are 
St.  Aidan's  College  (chiefly  for  non-gra- 
duates), Cuddesdon;  London  College  of 
Divinity,  Highbury ;  the  Leeds  Clergy 
School ;  Wyclifle  Hall,  Oxford ;  and  Eidley 
Hall,  Cambridge.  The  period  of  study  is 
generally  one  year  for  graduates,  two  for 
non-graduates.  The  course  of  preparation 
for  Holy  Orders  is  thorough  and  systematic, 
and,  where  possible,  pastoral  visitation  is 
made  an  essential  part  of  the  system  of 
training,  the  students  beins;  attached  as  lay 
helpers  to  the  parochial  clergy,  and  taking 
part  in  such  work  as  that  of  Sunday-schools, 
night-schools,  mission  services,  &o. —  Official 
Year  Booh  of  the  Cliurch  of  England,  1883, 
1886.     [H.] 

THEOLOGY  (From  GfAj,  God,  and 
Xdyos,  a  discourse).  A  discourse  C"ncerning 
God,  it  beinn;  the  biisiness  of  this  science 
to  treat  of  the  Deitjf.  The  heathens  had 
their  theologues  or  divines,  as  well  as  the 
Christians ;  and  Eusebius  and  Augustine 
distinguished  the  theology  of  the  heathens 
into  three  sorts :  first,  the  fabulous  and 
poetical  ;  secondly,  natural,  which  was 
explained  by  philosophy  and  physics;  the 
third  was  political  or  civil,  which  last  con- 
sisted chiefly  in  the  solemn  service  of  the 
gods,  and  in  the  belief  which  they  had  in 
oracles  and  divinations,  together  with  the 
ceremonies  wherewith  their  worship  was 
perfonned. 

Divinity  among  the  Christians  is  divided 
into  positive  and  scholastical ;  the  first 
being  founded  upon  fact  and  institution, 
having  the  Scriptures,  Councils,  and  Fathers 
for  its  bottom  and  foundation,  and,  properly 
speaking,  this  is  true  divinity ;  the  other, 
called  scholastical,  is  principally  supported 
by  reason,  which  is  made  use  of  to  show 
that  the  Christian  theology  contains  nothing 
inconsistent  with  natural  light ;  and  with 
this  view  it  is  that  Thomas  Aquinas  makes 
use  of  the  authority  of  philosophers,  and 
arguments  from  natural  reason,  because  he 
was  engaged  with  philosophers,  who  at- 
tacked the  Christian  religion  with  argu- 
ments from  those  topics. 

THEOPHORI  (Bibs  and  <i>4pa,).  See 
Ghristopliori. 

THIRTIETH  OF  JANUARY,  Form  of 
prayer  for.  This  day,  the  anniversary  of  the 
execution  of  Charles  I.,  was  appointed  to  be 
observed  as  a  day  of  fasting  and  humilia- 
tion  by  12   Car.  II.   cap.   30.     The  form 


THOMAS,  ST. 


733 


was  drawn  up  by  a  committee  of  Convoca- 
tion, and  enjoined  by  proclamation.  May 
1662.  Its  use,  together  with  that  of  the 
other  State  services  except  for  the  Accession,, 
was  discontinued  by  Royal  Warrant  issued 
Jan.  17,  1859.  [H.] 
THIRTY-NINE  ARTICLES  (See  Ar- 

THOMAS'S,  ST.,  DAY.  A  festival  of 
the  Christian  Church  observed  on  the  21st 
of  December,  in  commemoration  of  St. 
Thomas  the  apostle.  St.  Thomas  is  said  to 
have  preached  in  Parthia,  and  to  have  been 
buried  at  Edessa  (Euseb.  E.  E.  i.  13  :  iii. 
1 ;  Soorat.  H.  E.  i.  19  :  iv.  18).  St.  Chry- 
sostom  mentions  his  grave  at  Edessa  as 
being  one  of  the  four  genuine  tombs  of 
apostles,  the  others  being  those  of  SS. 
Peter,  Paul,  and  John  (Horn,  in  Heb.  26). 
Later  traditions  ascribe  to  him  the  founda- 
tion of  the  Christian  Church  in  Malabar, 
which  goes  by  the  name  of  "  The  Christians 
of  St.  Thomas,"  but  which  is  now  usually 
supjxised  to  have  been  founded  by  a  Nes- 
torian  missionarj^  of  the  name  of  Thomas.. 
St.  Thomas's  martyrdom  (whether  in  Persia 
or  India)  is  said  to  have  been  occasioned  by 
a  lance.  In  the  Greek  Church  he  is  com- 
memorated on  Oct.  6,  and  by  the  Indians 
on  July  1. — Albau  Butler's  Lives  of  the 
Saints  ;  Diet.  Bible,  1490.     [H.] 

THOMAS,  ST.,  CHRISTIANS  OP. 
These  Christians  claim  the  apostle  St. 
Thomas  as  their  founder,  and  still  survivors 
are  known  by  the  above  title.  The  district 
they  occupy  is  part  of  Malabar,  on  the 
western  side  of  the  southern  extremity  of 
India.  With  regard  to  their  very  early 
history  nothing  is  known  except  from  tra- 
dition ;  but  it  is  most  interesting  to  observe, 
that  in  that  remote  past  there  was  a  little 
nest  of  Christians  apart  from  the  religions 
around  them.  In  the  sixth  century  there 
are  certain  evidences  of  their  existence,  for 
Cosmas  Indicopleustes,  who  at  that  time 
visited  India,  speaks  of  a  Church  in  Malabar, 
"  where  the  pepper  grows,"  with  a  bishop 
ordained  and  sent  from  Persia,  and  clergy- 
men and  believers  (  Topographia  Christiana, 
lib.  iii. ;  Patrol.  Or.  Ixxxviii.  169 ;  cf.  lib. 
xi.  ib.  446).  In  the  ninth  century  Sighelm 
and  jEthelstan  were  sent  with  alms  to 
Rome  by  King  Alfred,  and  went  on  to- 
India  "to  St.  Thomas  and  St.  Bartholemew  "' 
(^Anglo-Sax.  Chron.  S.  anno  883,  p.  152, 
ed.  Thorpe;  Will.  Malmcsbury,  ii.  122). 
There  seems  a  probability  at  all  events,  as 
we  can  get  so  far  back,  that  this  branch- 
may  have  been,  in  accordance  with  the 
tradition,  grafted  by  St.  Thomas  himself. 
While  there  is  no  doubt  that  Thomas  Cana,. 
to  whom  some  ascribe  the  name,  worked  in 
that  part,  his  date  is  much  disputed ;  even, 
if  he  lived  just  before  the  sixth  century,  it, 


731 


THREE  ESTATES 


would  seem  improbable  that  such  a  settled 
Church  as  Cosmas  refers  to  should  have 
been,  so  firmly  established.  Christianity 
must  have  existed  two  centuries  before  his 
time  in  Malabar,  acording  to  his  testimony 
(See  on  the  one  side  La  Croze,  Histoire  du 
Christ,  des  Indes,  p.  46  ;  on  the  other 
Assemani,  Bibl.  Or,  vol.  iii.  p.  44.4).  The 
Christians  of  St.  Thomas  have  peculiar  ideas 
with  regard  to  rites,  according  very  much 
with  those  of  the  Nestorians.  They  allow 
three  sacraments — Baptism,  Orders,  and  the 
Holy  Eucharist;  they  receive  no  images, 
and  do  not  much  reverence  the  cross  ;  they 
observe  no  age  for  orders,  but  make  priests 
«ven  at  the  age  of  seven  ;  they  observe  the 
times  of  Advent  and  Lent,  and  the  festivals 
of  omr  Lord,  and  many  saints'  days.  For 
other  details  see  Howard's  I%e  Christians 
of  St.  Thomas  and  their  Liturgies;  Diet. 
Christ.  Ant.  1957.     [H.] 

THREE  ESTATES  OP  THE  REALM. 
The  Lords  Temporal,  Commons,  and  Clergy. 
By  the  Proclamation  of  Dec.  27, 1558,  the  use 
of  any  public  prayer,  rite  or  ceremony  other 
than  that  by  law  received,  was  forbidden 
untU  "  consultation  may  be  had  by  Parlia- 
ment, by  her  Majesty,  and  her  three  estates 
of  this  realm."  It  is  not  clear  what  "  the 
•clergy  "  meant,  since  the  Convocations  were 
certainly  not  consulted  about  Elizabeth's 
Prayer  Book.  The  general  opinion  is  that 
the  Three  Estates  here  mean  the  Lords 
Temporal,  the  Lords  Spiritual,  and  the 
House  of  Commons.     [H.] 

THRONE.  The  bishop's  principal  seat 
in  his  cathedral.  At  St.  Paul's  the  bishop 
has  two  thrones ;  that  at  the  end  of  the 
south  stalls,  its  general  situation  in  cathe- 
drals, probably  representing  the  episcopal 
throne,  properly  so  called,  which  he  as- 
sumed at  the  more  solemn  part  of  the  ser- 
vice ;  that  more  westerly  his  ordinary  seat, 
or  stall.  Li  old  times  the  bishop  of  London 
often  occupied  the  stall  usually  assigned  to 
the  dean,  as  is  still  the  custom  at  Ely  and 
Carlisle  from  the  bishop  being,  in  old  times, 
the  abbot  as  well.  The  bishop's  throne  in 
the  ancient  basilicas  and  churches  was  at 
the  apex  of  the  apsis,  a  semicircle  behind 
the  altar.  The  marble  chair  of  the  arch- 
bishop at  Canterbury,  in  which  he  is  en- 
throned, formerly  occupied  a  place  behind 
the  altar ;  a  remnant  of  the  old  arrange- 
ment, as  appears  from  Dart's  Sist.  and 
Antiq.  of  Canterbury. 

THURIFIC  ATL  In  times  of  persecution 
Christians  who  were  brought  to  be  ex- 
amined before  the  heathen  tribunal  were 
permitted  to  escape  punishment  by  casting 
frankincense  on  an  altar  dedicated  to  an 
idol.  This  was  of  course  an  act  of  idolatry, 
and  amounted  to  open  and  unreserved 
apostasy  :  some  however   there  were  who 


TIPPET 

were  betrayed  into  this  act  by  present  fear, 
rather  than  a  real  wish  to  deny  Christ,  and 
who  sought  afterwards,  by  a.  rigid  penance, 
the  peace  of  the  Church.  These  were 
called  Thurificati  (See  Libdlatici  and 
Sacrificati). 

TIABA.  The  name  of  the  pope's  triple 
crown.  The  tiara  and  keys  are  the  badges 
of  the  papal  dignity,  the  tiara  of  his  civU 
rank,  and  the  keys  of  his  jurisdiction;  for 
as  soon  as  the  pope  is  dead,  his  arms  are 
represepted  with  the  tiara  alone,  ■without 
the  keys.  The  ancient  tiara  was  a  round 
high  cap.  John  XIII.  first  encompassed 
it  with  a  crown ;  Boniface  VIII.  added  a 
second  crown ;  and  Benedict  XIII.  a  third. 

TILES,  ENCAUSTIC.  The  use  of  orna- 
mented tiles  in  churches  is  at  least  as  old  as 
the  Norman  sera,  and  was  never  discontinued 
till  the  fall  of  Gothic  art.  The  term  en- 
caustic means  that  the  colours  are  burnt  in ; 
which  again  means  two  different  things, 
viz. :  (1)  plain  tiles  each  of  one  colour,  but 
set  in  patterns  on  the  floor ;  and  (2)  tiles  of 
one  ground  colour  in  which  shallow  cavities 
are  stamped  while  they  are  soft,  and  then 
fluid  clay  of  some  other  colour  is  poured  in 
and  then  they  are  baked  or  "  fired  "  together, 
and  each  tile  shows  coloured  patterns  ac- 
cordingly which  do  not  wear  out,  besides 
the  larger  ai-rangement  of  them  on  the 
ground.  The  finer  tiles  of  this  kind  are 
often  glazed,  and  look  very  beautiful  xmtil 
the  glazing  wears  off,  which  soon  happens  if 
they  are  much  walked  over.  Many  of  the 
most  expensive  tile  pavements  of  twenty  or 
thirty  years  ago  have  become  quite  shabby. 
There  was  such  a  passion  for  them  after 
their  revival  in  modern  times,  that  Scott  and 
other  architects  used  to  pull  up  and  destroy 
or  sell  marble  pavements  to  substitute  tiles. 
The  most  striking  case  of  that  kind  was  at 
Exeter,  the  marble  paving  of  which  was 
bought  by  Lord  Dudley  and  laid  down  by 
him  in  the  nave  of  Worcester.  Of  course 
not  even  marble  will  retain  its  polish  when 
much  walked  upon,  but  it  remains  far 
superior  to  any  tiles  when  their  glaze  is 
rubbed  off.  Marble  and  tiles  do  not  mix 
well  together.  Large  and  good  flags  look 
better  than  tiles  which  have  got  shabby. 
Tiles  must  be  laid  on  concrete,  or  they  will 
not  keep  level ;  and  flags  should  be  for  another 
reason,  viz.  that  if  they  are  not,  the  damp 
on  the  under  side  makes  them  split.  This 
is  constantly  seen  in  house  passages.   [G-.] 

TIPPET.  In  the  74th  canon,  in  which 
decency  in  apparel  is  enjoined  to  ministers, 
it  is  appointed  that  "  All  deans,  masters  of 
colleges,  archdeacons,  and  prebendaries,  in 
cathedral  and  collegiate  churches  (being 
priests  or  deacons),  doctors  in  divinity,  law, 
and  physio,  bachelors  in  divinity,  masters  of 
arts  and  bachelors  of  law,  having  any  ecclesi- 


TITHES 

astical  living,  shall  usually  wear  gowns 
with  standing  collars  and  sleeves  straight 
at  the  hands,  or  wide  sleeves,  as  is  used  at  the 
universities,  with  hoods  or  tippets  of  silk  or 
sarsenet,  and  square  caps.  And  that  all  other 
ministers  admitted,  or  to  be  admitted,  into 
that  function  shall  also  usually  wear  the  like 
apparel  as  is  aforesaid,  except  tippets  only." 
And  in  the  58th  canon :  "  It  shaU  be  lawful 
for  such  ministers  as  are  not  graduates  to 
wear  upon  their  surplices,  instead  of  hoods, 
some  decent  tippet  of  black,  so  it  be  not 
silk."  It  is  supposed  that  the  present  black 
scarf  worn  by  the  English  clergy  repre- 
sents three  things :  1.  the  stole ;  2.  the 
chaplain's  scarf ;  3.  the  choir  tippet.  The 
chaplain's  scarf  is  a  remnant  of  the  ancient 
badges,  or  liveries,  worn  by  the  members 
of  noblemen's  households,  their  chaplains 
included.  The  choir  tippet  grew  out  of  the 
ancient  almutium,  or  amice,  that  is,  a  ves- 
ture which  covered  the  shoulders,  and  in- 
cluded the  hood :  the  liripipium,  or  pendent 
part  of  the  hood,  sometimes  hanging  singly 
behind  (as  in  our  modern  hoods),  some- 
times ia  duplicate  before,  like  the  scarf.  In 
process  of  time  the  hood  became  separated 
from  this  pendent  part  in  front,  and  hence 
the  choir  tippet.  It  is  certain  that  the 
tippet  so  called,  often  made  of  sables  or  furs, 
was  worn  in  the  form  of  the  scarf,  by  digni- 
taries of  the  Church  and  State  for  many  ages 
in  England.  The  sca,rf  has  been  called  a 
tippet  immemorially  in  Ireland,  and  within 
memory  in  many  parts  of  England.  The 
law  of  the  Church  therefore  seems  to  be 
this,  that  all  ecclesiastics  (whether  priests  or 
deacons)  being  prebendaries  or  of  higher 
rank  in  cathedral  and  collegiate  churches, 
and  aU  priests  or  deacons  being  Masters  of 
Arts  or  of  higher  degree,  may  wear  either 
hoods  or  tippets  of  silk :  and  all  non- 
graduate  ministers  (whether  priests  or 
deacons)  may  not  wear  hoods,  but  only 
tippets  not  of  silk.  Whence  the  tippet  is  to 
be  worn  by  all  clergymen.  The  58th  canon 
however  is  explicit  as  to  the  use  of  hoods  by 
graduates.  By  the  constant  usage  of 
•cathedrals,  and  now  almost  everywhere, 
both  hood  and  scarf  are  worn  by  aU 
graduates. — Tippets  of  the  Canons  Ecclesi- 
astic, by  G.  I.  French,  1850 ;  Jebb  (Bp.), 
Charge  to  the  Clergy  of  Limerick;  Jebb 
(Dr.),  Chor.  Serv.  p.  215. 

TITHES,  in  the  religious  application  of 
the  phrase,  are  a  certaiu  portion,  or  allot- 
ment, for  the  maintenance  of  the  priesthood, 
being  the  tenth  part  of  the  produce  of  land, 
cattle,  or  other  branches  of  wealth.  It 
is  an  income,  or  revenue,  common  both 
to  the  Jewish  and  Christian  priesthood. 

The  priests  among  the  Jews  had  no  share 
allowed  them  in  the  division  of  the  land, 
that  they  might  attend  whoUy  upon  Divine 


TITHES 


735 


service,  and  not  have  their  thoughts  diverted 
by  the  business  of  tillage,  or  feeding  cattle, 
or  any  other  secular  emplo3Tnent.  Their 
maintenance  arose  chiefly  from  the  first- 
fruits,  offerings  and  tithes. 

The  ancient  Christians,  it  is  generally 
thought,  held  the  Divine  right  of  tithes,  that 
is,  that  the  payment  .of  tithes  was  not 
merely  a  ceremonial  or  political  command, 
but  of  moral  and  perpetual  obligation  (see 
Bp.  Andrewes,  De  decimis ;  Carleton,  Divine 
Right  of  Titltes,  c.  4);  though  Bellarmine  (rfe 
Gler.  i.  c.  25),  Selden  {Hist,  of  Tithes,  c.  4), 
and  others  place  them  upon  another  foot. 
St.  Jerome  says  expressly  that  the  law 
about  tithes  (to  which  he  adds  first-fruits) 
was  to  be  understood  to  continue  in  its  full 
force  in  the  Chiistian  Church  (Hieron. 
Com.  in  Mai.  iii.).  And  both  Origen  atjd 
St.  Augustine  confirm  the  same  opinion 
(Grig.  Horn.  ii.  in  Num.  xviii. :  Aug.  Com. 
in  Ps.  cxlvi.). 

But  why,  then,  were  not  tithes  exacted 
by  the  apostles  at  first,  or  by  the  fathers  in 
the  ages  immediately  following  ?  For  it  is 
generally  agreed  that  tithes  were  not  the  ori- 
ginal maintenance  of  ministers  under  the 
gospel.  It  is  answered,  first,  that  tithes 
were  paid  to  the  priests  and  Levites,  in  tlie 
time  of  Christ  and  His  apostles;  and  the 
synagogue  must  be  buried  before  these 
things  could  be  orderly  brought  into  use  in 
the  Church.  Secondly,  in  the  times  of  the 
New  Testament,  there  was  an  extraordinary 
maintenance,  by  a  community  of  all  things ; 
which  supplied  the  want  of  tithes.  Thirdly, 
paying  tithes,  as  the  circumstances  of  the 
Church  then  stood,  could  not  conveniently 
be  practised;  for  this  requires  that  some 
whole  state  or  kingdom  profess  Christianit\', 
and  the  Church  be  under  the  protection  of 
the  magistrates,  which  was  not  the  case  in 
the  apostolical  times.  Besides,  the  inhabi- 
tants of  the  country,  from  whom  the  tithes 
of  fruits  must  come,  were  the  latest  converts 
to  Cliristianity  (Bingham,  Ant.  v.,  v.  2). 

The  common  opinion  is,  that  tithes  began 
first  to  be  generally  settled  upon  the  Church 
in  the  fourth  century,  when  the  magistrates 
protected  the  Church,  and  the  empire  was 
generally  converted  from  heathenism. 
Some  think  Constantine  settled  them  by  a 
law  upon  the  Church ;  but  there  is  no  law 
of  that  emperor's  now  extant  that  makes 
express  mention  of  any  such  thing.  How- 
ever, it  is  certain  tithes  were  paid  to  the 
Church  before  the  end  of  the  fourth  century, 
as  Selden  has  proved  out  of  Cassian,  Eugip- 
pius,  and  others.  The  reader  may  see  this 
whole  matter  historically  deduced,  through 
many  centuries,  by  that  author  (See  Hist,  of 
Tithes,  c.  5,  seq.). 

The  custom  of  paying  tithes,  or  ofiering  a 
tenth   of  what  a  man   enjoys,   is  not  so 


736 


TITHES 


peculiar  to  the  Jewish  and  Christian  law, 
but  that  we  find  some  traces  of  it  even 
among  the  heathens.  Xenophon  has  pre- 
served an  inscription  upon  a  column  near  a 
temple  of  Plana,  whereby  the  people  were 
admonished  to  offer  the  tenth  part  of  their 
revenues  every  year  to  the  goddess.  And 
Festus  assures  us  the  ancients  gave  tithe 
of  eveiything  to  their  gods. 

Before  the  promulgation  of  the  law, 
Abraham  set  the  example  of  paying  tithes, 
in  giving  the  tenth  of  the  spoils  to  Mel- 
chisedech,  king  of  Salem,  on  his  return  from 
his  expedition  against  Chedorlaomer  and 
the  four  confederate  kings.  And  Jacob 
imitated  the  piety  of  his  grandfather  in  this 
respect,  when  he  vowed  to  the  Lord  the 
tithe  of  all  the  substance  he  might  acquire 
in  Mesopotamia. 

Tithes  were  not  in  very  early  days  so 
important  an  item  of  English  Church  en- 
dowment as  is  often  supposed.  It  must  be 
remembered  that  until  almost  the  close  of 
the  Saxon  period  they  were  merely  volun- 
tary offerings,  which  could  be  given  or 
withheld  at  pleasure ;  and  it  was  not  until 
much  later  (thirteenth  century)  that  any 
effort  was  made  by  the  clergy  to  enforce 
their  payment.  The  difiSculty  of  collecting 
and  of  disjwsing  of  offerings  in  kind  which 
were  useless  except  for  the  price  they  would 
command,  and  which,  on  the  other  hand, 
could  not  safely  be  sent  along  roads  infested 
with  banditti  to  a  distant  market,  probably 
conduced  to  lessen  their  importance  in  Saxon 
times.  The  history  of  the  growth  of  the 
legal  right  to  tithe  in  England  is  as  follows : 

"  It  is  impossible  to  say  when  the  duty 
of  setting  apart  a  tenth  of  the  increase  of 
each  man's  land  and  labouri  was  first  taught 
in  the  Christian  Church.  Probably  in  the 
Apostolic  age.  We  may  e  t  any  rate  take 
it  as  certain  that,  when  /the  Gospel  was 
brought  into  England  by  St.  Augustine, 
this  was  one  of  the  duties  impressed  by  him 
on  his  converts,  and  observed  by  them.  As 
Christianity  spread  over  the  land,  exercising 
an  ever-increasing  infiuence  over  the  inhabi- 
tants, and  requiring  largely  increased  means 
for  the  maintenance  of  its  growing  work, 
the  disposition  to  ask  and  the  willingness 
to  give  tithes,  would  naturally  become  more 
marked.  The  Christian  duty  of  tithe-paying 
was  not  likely  to  be  underrated  or  forgotten 
by  those  for  whose  benefit  the  tithes  were 
given.  We  may  be  quite  sure  as  much  as 
possible  was  made  of  the  moral  obligation 
to  pay,  and  of  the  evil  results  of  non- 
payment. But  the  Church  went  no  further 
than  this  at  first.  While  all  were  exhorted 
to  pay  tithe,  and  the  devout  did  so,  those 
who  refused  broke  no  canon  of  the  Church, 
and  therefore  incurred  no  ecclesiastical  cen- 
sure.    It  was  not  until  the  eighth  century 


TITHES 

that  the  Church  of  England  began  to  demand 
from  her  members  what  hitherto  she  had 
been  content  to  receive  as  a  free-will  offering 
or  not  at  all.  The  payment  of  tithes  thus 
became  not  only  a  Christian  duty,  but  also 
a  matter  of  Church  law.  The  Anglo-Saxon 
kings  to  some  extent — ^how  far  it  is  perhaps 
impossible  now  to  ascertain — lent  themselves 
to  the  new  demand,  and  seem  to  have  given 
to  some  at  least  of  the  decrees  of  ecclesiastical 
synods  the  force  and  authority  of  Eoyal 
laws.  What  the  direct  result  of  these 
attempts  to  invest  the  Church  with  a  legal 
right  to  tithes  may  have  been  is  not  known, 
but  apparently  it  was  not  very  considerable. 
The  times  were  unsettled,  and  even  the 
frequency  with  which  the  laws  were  re- 
pealed, and  as  it  were  re-enacted,  is  a  sig- 
nificant comment  on  the  manner  of  their 
reception.  Selden,  speaking  of  this  'fuU- 
nesse  of  laws,'  parenthetically  remarks, 
'Howsoever  they  were  little  obeyed' 
(Review  on  ch.  viii.  p.  481).  But  we  can 
scarcely  be  wrong  in  assuming  that  these 
civil  and  ecclesiastical  laws,  although  they 
may  have  had  comparatively  little  weight 
as  laws,  were  yet  influential  in  confirming 
and  extending  the  custom  of  tithe-paying, 
which  under  the  interested  care  of  the 
Church  had  for  centuries  been  growing  up. 

"  It  is  in  this  that  their  real  importance 
lies.  The  fact  that  the  Church,  with  the 
awful  powers  she  was  supposed  to  possess 
over  the  destinies  of  men,  demanded  the 
consecration  of  a  tenth  to  the  service  of 
God,  and  the  additional  fact  that  the  State 
endorsed  this  demand,  must  have  aoted 
powerfully  on  men's  minds,  even  although 
disobedience  was  not  visited  with  either 
excommunication  or  outlawry.  Without, 
therefore,  enquiring  too  nicely  into  the 
precise  import  of  any  particular  law,  or  the 
actual  practice  at  any  particular  period,  we 
may  safely  conclude  tbat,  under  the  pressure 
of  events,  the  custom  of  tithe-paying  was, 
notwithstanding  many  drawbacks,  growing 
and  extending  throughout  the  Saxon  period. 
The  Conquest,  as  Mr.  Brewer  shows,  gave  a 
great  impetus  to  the  tithe  system. 

"  What  was  this  custom  ?  It  was  the 
dedication  of  a  tenth  of  each  man's  increase 
to  '  God  and  Holy  Church,'  but  not  neces- 
sarily to  any  particular  priest  or  parish. 
Indeed,  the  custom  of  paying  tithes  began, 
to  develope  itself  before  there  were  any 
parishes  in  the  modern  sense  of  the  word. 
At  first  the  tithes  and  offerings  were  made 
at  the  central  church  of  the  diocese,  and 
were  dispensed  by  the  bishop.  The  dedica- 
tion was  equally  complete,  whether  the- 
tenth  went  to  increase  the  episcopal  fund, 
to  fill  the  coffers  of  some  wealthy  convent 
at  a  distance,  or  to  pay  for  the  support  of 
the  poor  priest  near  at  hand.     Therefore, 


TITHES 

after  parishes  were  formed,  and  payment  of 
tithe  to  the  bishop  had  ceased  to  be  practised, 
although  it  was  obviously  the  most  natural 
course  to  devote  the  tithes  of  the  land  in  a 
parish  to  the  support  of  the  parson  of  that 
parish,  it  was  not  imusual,  and  practically 
it  was  not  discountenanced  by  the  authori- 
ties, that  a  landowner  should  hand  over  the 
whole  or  a  defined  part  of  his  tithes  to 
some  monastery  or  convent,  in  perpetuity. 
This  was  called  a  consecration  or  appropri- 
ation. It  could  only  be  effected  by  an 
actual  deed  of  grant,  or  by  a  practice  of 
payment  of  such  long  continuance  as  to 
create  a  title  by  prescription.  In  the 
absence  of  any  consecration,  the  duty  to 
pay  tithes  to  the  parson,  and  the  right  of 
the  parson  to  demand  them,  were  assumed 
without  any  special  dedication. 

"  The  ease  and  frequency  of  consecrations 
and  appropriations  may  perhaps  account,  to 
some  extent,  for  the  apparent  hesitation  on 
the  part  of  the  clergy  in  early  times  to  use 
the  laws  for  the  purpose  of  compelling  pay- 
ment of  their  tithes.  So  long  as  these 
appropriations  were  allowed,  it  was  useless 
to  sue  a  man  in  respect  of  an  obligation 
which  he  could  determine  whenever  he 
chose.  But  as  soon  as  appropriations  were 
stopped  by  ecclesiastical  authority,  so  that 
payment  to  the  parson  could  not  be  evaded 
by  payment  to  somebody  else,  we  find  the 
parson  bringing  his  action  or  suit  and  en- 
forcing his  demand.  The  nature  of  his 
remedy  varied  in  different  circumstances. 
If  his  title  to  the  tithe  was  denied  he  had 
to  go  to  the  Common  Law  Court,  but  if  it 
was  merely  a  case  of  non-payment,  or  '  sub- 
traction of  tithe,'  the  Ecclesiastical  Court 
was  the  proper  tribunal.  This,  however,  was 
only  a  matter  of  arrangement  by  the  State 
to  prevent  collisiou  between  the  two  sets  of 
courts.  The  right  had  become  a  part  of 
the  law  of  the  land.  This  state  of  things 
was  not  reached  until  the  beginning  of  the 
thirteenth  century,  by  which  time  the  cus- 
tom of  paying  tithe  had  become  so  firmly 
established  and  so  generally  observed  as  to  be 
indisputable,  while  the  possibility  of  de- 
frauding the  parish  by  bestowing  the  tithe 
elsewhere  was  removed.  The  landowner 
was  not  only  bound  to  pay  tithe,  but  he 
was  bound  to  pay  it  to  the  parson  of  his 
<9wn  parish.  Thus  the  parochial  right  to  tithes 
became  established  and  settled  as  a  common 
right,  or,  as  Coke  calls  it,  part  of  lex  terrse. 

"  The  payment  of  tithes  being  once  esta- 
blished as  a  matter  of  common  right,  it  be- 
comes unimportant  to  enquire  for  any 
specific  dedication  to  the  Church  of  the 
tithe,  arising  from  any  particular  law.  Tithe 
is  due  '  of  right '  to  the  parson  of  a  parish 
from  all  land  in  that  parish,  unless  there 
■can  be  proved  an  appropriation  dating  from 


TITHES 


737 


the  time  when  appropriations  were  valid. 
But  it  remains  none  the  less  true  that  the 
origin  of  tithes  in  England  is  to  be  found 
not  in  any  law  but  in  the  free-will  offerings 
of  the  people.  The  establishment  of  the 
right  to  tithe  was  only  the  legal  expres- 
sion of  a  custom  in  which  the  nation  ac- 
quiesced. That  custom  began  in  the  purely 
voluntary  gifts  of  individuals ;  it  grew  in 
the  manner  and  under  the  influences  above 
described.  No  real  compulsion,  so  far  as 
we  know,  was  used.  It  continued  to  grow, 
getting  stronger  and  more  established,  until 
at  last  the  universal  consent  of  the  nation 
turned  this  custom  into  a  part  of  the  common 
law  of  England.  Thus  it  is  true  that  it  was 
the  voluntary  devotion  of  individuals,  whose 
numbers,  increasing  age  after  age,  at  last 
comprised  the  whole  nation,  which  conferred 
on  the  Church  of  England  her  tithes." — 
Brewer's  Endowments  and  Establishment. 
Editor's  notes. 

The  position  of  things  at  the  time  when 
the  obligation  to  pay  tithe  to  the  parish 
priest  had  become  part  of  the  common  law 
was  this.  The  tithe  in  a  great  number  of 
parishes  had  been  successlully  assigned  to 
monasteries,  which  however  were  required 
by  law  to  give  back  a  portion  (small  tithe) 
to  the  clergyman  fulfilling  the  duties  of  the 
cure,  retaining  the  remainder  (great  tithe) 
for  their  own  use.  This  was  the  origin  of 
vicarages.  Where  there  had  been  no 
mooastic  appropriation  of  tithes,  the  whole 
were  due  to  the  parson.  On  the  dissolution 
of  the  monasteries  the  appropriated  tithes 
passed  into  lay  hands  and  for  the  most  part 
have  so  remained  ever  since. 

There  are  three  kinds  of  tithes : 

(1)  Predial,  i.e.  arising  immediately  out  of 
land,  as  corn,  hay,  wood,  fruits,  &c. 

(2)  Mixed,  i.e.produce  of  animals  receiving 
their  nourishment  from  the  land,  as  calves, 
lambs,kids,  pigs,chickens,  milk,  cheese,  eggs. 

(3)  Personal,  i.e.  arising  out  of  the  per- 
sonal labour  of  the  parishioners. 

As  to  predial  and  mixed  tithes,  they 
were  originally  payable  in  kind,  but  in  1836 
the  Tithe  Conamutation  Act  (6  &  7  Will. 
IV.  ch.  71)  was  passed,  by  which  a  rent- 
charge  graduated  from  time  to  time  accord- 
ing to  the  price  of  corn,  was  substituted. 
The  tithe  rent-charge  of  hops,  fruit,  and 
garden  produce,  known  as  "  extraordinary 
tithe,"  was  so  arranged  as  to  become  a  kind 
of  shifting  burden  on  the  land,  payable  or 
not  according  as  the  special  cultivation  was 
adopted  or  abandoned.  Its  rate  was  con- 
siderably higher  than  that  of  ordinary  tithe. 
It  has  been  a  fruitful  cause  of  irritation 
between  the  clergy  and  the  tithe-payers,  and 
has  at  last  been  abolished  by  Act  of  Par- 
liament (49  &  50  Vict.  ch.  54).  A  fixed 
charge  will  take  its  place. 

3  B 


738 


TITHES 


Personal  tithe  is  practically  extinct.  By 
a  statute  of  Ed.  VI.  (2  &  3  Ed.  VI.  ch.  13) 
it  can  only  be  demanded  -where  it  is  shown 
to  have  been  customarily  paid  for  forty 
years  prior  to  the  Act.  By  the  same  Act 
restrictions  are  placed  on  the  payment 
of  other  customary  offerings.  These  were 
once  numerous,  but  have  long  since  dis- 
appeared. Easter  offerings  form  the  only 
survival  of  these  payments,  and  by  some  are 
thought  to  represent  personal  tithe  also. 
Easter  offerings  are  said  to  amount  to  2d. 
a  head  for  every  parishioner  old  enough 
to  be  a  communicant,  except  in  London, 
where  the  charge  is  supposed,  for  some  un- 
known reason  to  be  id.  Easter  offerings 
cannot  be  legally  demanded  unless  a  cus- 
tom to  pay  them  in  the  particular  place  is 
proved.     [L.  T.  D.] 

The  great  fall  in  rents  of  late  has  natu- 
rally raised  discussions  about  the  effect  of 
the  Commutation  Act,  and  the  Dissenters 
have  availed  themselves  of  it  to  get  up  an 
agitation  against  tithes,  nominally  on  behalf 
of  the  farmers,  who  it  is  quite  plain  are  not 
the  parties  affected,  as  the  rent  of  all  land 
inevitably  varies  with  whatever  rates  or 
charges  they  pay  by  arrangement  with  their 
landlords.  On  the  other  hand,  there  is  no 
doubt  that  a  fixed  rent  charge  (with  the 
slight  variations  due  to  the  mode  of  reckon- 
ing it  under  the  Act  by  corn  averages  for 
the  previous  seven  years)  is  as  hard  upon 
the  landowners  as  the  fixed  charges  under 
their  own  family  settlements  and  mortgages, 
which  are  never  made  proportionate  to  the 
rent.  Another  grievance  made  by  some  of 
these  writers  against  tithes  is  that  the 
averages  work  injustice  with  the  present 
low  prices  of  com.  But  that  again  is  an 
incident  of  every  kind  of  commutation  or 
rent  charge.  And  all  these  agitators  find  it 
convenient  to  forget  that  the  excess  arising 
from  both  the  above  causes  is  much  more 
than  counterbalanced  by  the  fact  that,  as 
Sir  J.  Caird  put  it,  the  tithe  in  1836,  when 
most  of  the  commutations  were  made,  was 
about  four  millions  on  thirty-three  of  rental, 
while  in  1876  it  was  the  same  four  milhons 
(and  now  rather  less)  on  fifty  miUions — 
subject,  no  doubt,  to  a  considerable  decrease 
of  rental  since,  but  not  yet  to  anything  like 
the  former  thirty-three.  Moreover,  it 
should  be  remembered  that  the  parochial 
clergy  only  receive  about  £2,410,000  of  the 
four  millions  of  tithe,  the  other  40  per  cent, 
of  it  going  to  impropriators  of  various  kinds, 
according  to  a  parliamentary  return  quoted 
by  one  of  the  agitators  for  another  purpose. 
Eating  of  Tithes  has  been  the  subject  of 
litigation  which  is  not  concluded,  and  it  is 
better  not  to  anticipate  the  result.  Some 
Welsh  justices  issued  a  distress  warrant  on 
a  rector  for  rates  on  tithes  which  he  had 


TOBIT 

been  unable  to  recover.  The  Acts  of  6  & 
7  W.  IV.  c.  71  and  1  Vict.  c.  6,  s.  8,  to- 
gether enact  that  the  rates  may  be  assessed 
on  the  owner  of  the  tithe,  but  recovered/rom, 
the  occupiers  of  the  land  from  which  it 
arises  on  giving  them  21  days'  notice ;  and 
the  first  Act  contains  provisions  for  the 
occupier  who  so  pays  to  deduct  it  from  his: 
next  payment  of  rent.  Legal  opinions  have 
been  given  that  the  justices  were  wrong, 
which  is  all  that  can  be  safely  said  at  pre- 
sent.    [G.] 

TITLE  (See  Orders).  Canon  33:  "It 
has  been  long  since  provided  by  many 
decrees  of  the  ancient  Fathers,  that  none 
should  be  admitted,  either  deacon  or  priest, 
who  had  not  first  some  certain  place  where 
he  might  use  his  function :  according  to- 
which  examples  we  do  ordain,  that  hence- 
forth no  person  shall  be  admitted  into  sacred 
orders,  except  (1)  he  shall  at  that  time 
exhibit  to  the  bishop,  of  whom  he  desireth 
imposition  of  hands,  a  presentation  of  himself 
to  some  ecclesiastical  preferment  then  void 
in  the  diocese ;  or  (2)  shall  bring  to  the 
said  bishop  a  true  and  undoubted  certificate,, 
that  either  he  is  provided  of  some  church 
within  the  said  diocese  where  he  may  attend 
the  cure  of  souls,  or  (3)  of  some  minister's 
place  vacant  either  in  the  cathedral  church 
of  that  diocese,  or  in  some  other  collegiate- 
church  therein  also  situate,  where  he  may 
execute  his  ministry ;  or  (4)  that  he  is  a 
fellow,  or  in  right  as  a  fellow,  or  (5)  to  be  a 
conduct  or  chaplain  in  some  college  in 
Cambridge  or  Oxford ;  or  (6)  except  he  be 
a  Master  of  Arts  of  five  years'  standing,  that 
liveth  of  his  own  charge  in  either  of  the 
universities;  or  (7)  except  by  the  bishop 
himself  that  doth  ordain  him  minister,  he  be 
shortly  after  to  be  admitted  either  to  some 
benefice  or  curateship  then  void.  And  if 
any  bishop  shall  admit  any  person  into  the 
ministry  that  hath  none  of  these  titles,  as 
is  aforesaid,  then  he  shall  keep  and  maintain, 
him  with  all  things  necessary,  till  he  do 
prefer  him  to  some  ecclesiastical  living ;  and 
if  the  said  bishop  refuse  so  to  do,  he  shall  be- 
suspended  by  the  archbishop,  being  assisted- 
with  another  bishop,  from  giving  of  orders 
by  the  space  of  a  year."  It  legally  follows 
from  this  last  clause  that  a  bishop  may,  if 
he  pleases,  ordain  any  man  of  good  private 
means  without  any  of  the  specified  qualifi- 
cations. 

TOBIT,  THE  BOOK  OP.  An  apociyphal 
book  of  Scripture.  It  was  written  in  Chal- 
dee,  by  some  Babylonian  Jew,  and  seems, 
in  its  original  draught,  to  have  been  the- 
memoirs  of  the  family  to  which  it  relates,, 
first  begun  by  Tohit,  then  continued  by 
Tobias,  and  finished  by  some  other  of  the 
family ;  and  afterward  digested  by  the- 
Chaldee  author  into  that  form  in  which  we- 


TOLERATIOiSr 

now  have  it.  It  was  translated  out  of  the 
Chaldee  into  LatLti  by  St.  Jerome,  and  his 
translation  is  that  which  we  have  in  the 
Vulgar  Latin  edition  of  the  Bible.  But 
there  is  a  Greek  version  much  older  than 
this,  from  which  was  made  the  Syriac 
version,  and  also  that  which  we  have  in 
English  among  the  apocryphal  writers,  in 
our  Bible.  But  the  Chaldee  original  is  not 
now  extant.  The  Hebrew  copies  of  this 
book,  as  weU  as  of  that  of  Judith,  seem  to 
be  of  a  modem  composition  (See  Dr.  Wace's 
Apocrypha). 

Two  of  the  offertory  sentences  are  from 
the  book  of  Tobit. 

TOLEBATION.  The  old  legal  meaning 
of  "  toleration  "  was  the  permission  to  profess 
religious  opinions  different  from  those  of  the 
established  religion  for  the  time,  without 
liability  to  prosecution  or  civil  disabihty  of 
any  kind.  And  in  that  sense  "  toleration " 
cannot  be  said  to  exist  any  longer,  because 
everybody  is  at  liberty  to  do  so,  provided 
such  opinions  are  not  uttered  with  such 
indecency  and  offence  to  people  in  general 
as  to  be  what  is  called  a  blasphemous 
libel ;  just  as  some  degree  of  violence  of 
expression  of  political  opinion  is  a  "  seditious 
libel "  (see  Blaspliemy).  It  is  evident  that 
no  a  priori  rule  or  definition  of  them  can 
be  laid  down ;  the  question  of  degree  has  to 
be  determined  by  the  jury  that  tries  each 
particular  case.  Moreover  it  is  to  be  re- 
membered that  the  dictum  of  several  great 
judges,  that  Christianity  is  part  of  the 
common  law  of  the  land,  has  never  been 
overruled.  It  is  too  often  forgotten  that 
toleration  by  the  State,  which  means  im- 
munity from  civil  disabilities  or  prosecution 
on  public  grounds,  is  an  entirely  different 
thing  from  the  absurd  demand  that  any 
Church,  whether  "  established  "  or  non-estab^ 
hshed,  shall  not  be  allowed  and  enabled  to 
eject  from  its  own  body,  and  to  silence  in  its 
own  places  of  meeting,  members,  or  non- 
members,  who  preach  or  act  contrary  to  its 
own  standards  of  faith  or  ritual,  provided 
they  are  not  immoral,  in  which  case  no 
civil  court  will  assist  them,  any  more 
than  the  owners  of  copyright  of  immoral 
books,  according  to  a  famous  decision  of 
Lord  Eldon's.  Within  those  limits  the 
same  court  would  decide  one  case  in  favour 
of  Popery  or  Unitarianism  and  the  next 
against  them,  because  between  different 
parties.  All  this  is  perfectly  well  known 
and  recognised  by  the  Dissenters,  who  occa- 
sionally apply  to  the  courts  of  law  on  these 
grounds  with  success ;  and  yet  people  go  on 
uttering  platitudes  about  the  intolerance  of 
the  Church  of  England  because  its  authorities 
are  obliged  every  now  and  then  to  resort  to 
the  same  kind  of  proceedings  to  restrain 
ministers  who  are  paid  for  preaching  and 


TOLERATION 


739 


acting  according  to  its  written  standards  of 
doctrine  and  ritual,  from  doing  just  the 
contrary.  And  they  do  not  choose  to  see 
that  exactly  the  same  proceedings  would 
take  place,  only  much  more  summarily  and 
effectually  through  the  civil  courts,  if  the 
Church  were  disestablished.  What  Dis- 
senters mean  and  want  by  disestablishing 
the  Ciiurch  is  not  liberty  of  doctrine,  but 
simply  robbery ;  for  liberty  of  doctrine  has 
long  been  unlimited,  except  that  clergymen 
have  not  liberty  to  take  their  wages  for 
doing  one  thing,  and  to  do  the  opposite  thiug, 
as  a  great  judge  said  in  a  celebrated  case. 

The  history  of  the  "  Toleration  Acts," so  far 
as  is  material  now,  is  this.  So  long  as  the 
established  reUgion  was  that  of  Rome,  there 
was  no  such  thing  as  legal  toleration,  and 
the  more  so  as  the  Papists  became  more 
afraid  of  Protestantism.  That  is,  there  was 
no  toleration  by  law,  though  it  was  a  matter 
of  discretion  with  the  king  and  the  bishops 
in  those  days  how  far  the  laws  de  hxretico 
comiurendo,  which  existed  from  the  time  of 
5  E.  II.  ses.  2,  c.  5,  should  be  put  in  force. 
That  first  Act,  which  was  passed  in  1381, 
was  to  enable  the  Roman  Church  to  put 
down  Wiclif  and  his  followers.  During  all 
Henry  VIII.'s  gradual  changes  of  his  o\vn 
religion  and  the  State's,  heretics  or  dis- 
senters either  way  were  burnt  and  be- 
headed impartially.  Nor  in  the  early  days 
of  Protestantism  was  any  toleration  of  Pa- 
pists much  thought  of,  for  the  two  very 
solid  reasons,  that  Popery  was  then  amply 
proved  to  mean  either  rebellion  or  unUmited 
persecution,  according  as  it  had  the  lower  or 
the  upper  hand.  The  toleration  of  the 
Puritans  while  they  were  dominant  was 
testified  by  their  abolition  and  confiscation 
and  ejectment  of  every  bishop  and  clergy- 
man who  would  not  take  their  tests, 
innumerably  more  than  the  usurpers  of 
church  benefices  who  were  again  turned  out 
at  the  Restoration  if  they  would  not  con- 
form. We  are  continually  being  harangued 
about  the  tyranny  of  turning  out  the  robbers, 
if  they  refused  to  conform,  but  never  of  the 
robbery.  The  first  express  Toleration  Act 
was  1  W.  &  M.  c.  18,  for  the  relief  of  Pro- 
testant Dissenters.  These  penalties,  which 
had  been  in  force  against  such  as  absented 
themselves  from  church,  or  frequented  un- 
lawful conventicles,  were  remitted,  if  they 
took  the  oaths  of  allegiance  and  supremacy, 
and  made  a  declaration  against  transubstan- 
tiation.  Papists  and  persons  who  denied  the 
Trinity  were  excluded  from  the  benefits  of 
the  Act.  An  attempt  was  made  at  the  same 
time  to  pass  a  comprehensive  Bill,  in  order 
to  admit  Dissenters  by  altering  the  liturgy, 
and  making  certain  portions  of  it  discre- 
tionary; but  it  failed,  and  has  not  again 
been   renewed.      The  Legislature  has  no 

3  B  2 


740 


TOLERATION 


more  right  to  do  that  than  to  alter  the 
standards  of  faith  and  ritual  of  any  sect, 
without  its  own  consent.  53  Geo.  III.  c. 
160,  repealed  the  clause  in  the  Toleration 
Act  which  excepted  Unitarians;  and  the 
statutes  of  18  Geo.  III.  c.  60,  31  Geo.  III. 
c.  32,  and  43  Geo.  III.  c.  30,  removed  the 
penalties  and  disahilities  to  which  Romanists 
had  been  subjected.  By  the  "Catholic  Eman- 
cipation Act "  (10  Geo.  IV.  c.  7)  Romanists 
were  restored  to  the  enjoyment  of  all  civil 
rights,  and  by  the  Act  2  &  3  WilL  IV.  c.  115, 
it  was  provided  that  Roman  Cathohcs  should 
be  .subject  to  the  same  laws  as  applied  to 
Protestant  Dissenters.  By  the  Acts  of  7 
&  8  Vict.  c.  102,  9  &  10  Vict.  c.  59,  and  21 
&  22  Vict.  c.  48,  both  Romanists  and  Jews 
are  relieved  from  all  enactments  that  had 
been  against  them,  and  are  thus  admitted  to 
all  the  privileges  of  the  constitution.  The 
law  commonly  called  the  "Test  and  Cor- 
poration Acts,"  that  all  taking  any  office. 
Dissenters  or  not,  Should  have  taken  the 
sacrament  of  the  Lord's  supper  according  to 
the  rites  of  the  Church  of  England,  within 
a  year,  were  abrogated  by  9  Geo.  IV.  c.  17. 
By  the  "Ecclesiastical  Titles  Act,"  3  851, 
though  repealed  as  to  the  penalties  in  1858, 
it  is  unlawful  for  Roman  bishops  to  use 
English  territorial  titles,  which  Pope  Pius 
IX.  had  presumed  to  confer.  Another  con- 
cession to  Dissenters  was  made  by  18  &  19 
Vict.  c.  36 ;  by  which  they  are  allowed  to 
certify  their  places  of  worship  to,  and  register 
them  with,  the  registrar-general  of  births, 
deaths,  and  marriages,  and  when  so  certiBed 
they  are  exempt  from  all  interference.  By 
19  &  20  Vict.  c.  119,  ministers  of  religious 
bodies  outside  the  Church  of  England  are 
empowered  to  officiate  at  marriages  in  their 
registered  chapels,  the  superintendent-regis- 
trar of  the  district  being  present.  By  a  later 
Act  of  1880  any  others  beside  the  ordained 
ministers  of  the  Church  of  England  are 
allowed  to  perform  the  bmial  service  in 
churchyards,  and  any  "  Christian  "  burial 
service  that  they  choose  (See  Burial'). 

At  that  time  of  the  "  Emancipation  Act " 
of  1829,  nothing  looked  less  formidable 
or  aggressive  than  Popery.  Yet  before  the 
Act  had  attained  the  age  of  21  years  all 
England  was  resounding  with  the  phrase 
"  Papal  Aggression,"  and  Lord  Melbourne 
said  that  "  all  the  clever  men  had  been  on 
one  side  in  1829,  and  all  the  fools  on  the 
other,  and  yet  all  that  the  fools  predicted 
had  come  to  pass,  and  nothing  that  the 
clever  men  had"  (See  Eccl.  Titles  Act). 
The  many  Acts  that  have  since  been  passed 
at  the  demand  of  the  Dissenters  have  nothing 
to  do  with  toleration,  and  have  latterly  be- 
come just  the  contrary,  being  simply  the 
stealingof  property  given  forthe  maintenance 
of  the  Church  and  of  education  for  it.     And 


TONSURE 

though  every  kind  of  statistics  proves  that 
Churchmen  contribute  to  all  general  charities 
both  civil  and  religious,  and  to  schools,  three 
times  as  much  as  all  the  Dissenters  together, 
the  latter  claim,  and  have  in  many  cases  got, 
equal  or  more  control  over  them,  and  are 
now  set  upon  destroying  all  voluntary  schools 
because  they  are  generally  Church  schools. 
They  have  succeeded,  by  the  Education 
Act  of  1870  and  its  successors,  in  making 
Churchmen  who  maintain  their  own  schools 
pay  a  double  tax :  which  those  whose  duty 
and  profession  it  is  to  defend  the  interests 
of  the  Church  in  Parliament  did  nothing  to 
prevent.  Not  long  ago  the  Dissenters,  or 
persons  in  the  same  interest,  tried  a  lawsuit 
to  prevent  a  new  foundation  of  a  Church  of 
England  college  at  Oxford,  having  destroyed 
alrwdy  the  ecclesiastical  character  of  the  old 
ones.  And  now  they  are  themselves  trying 
to  establish  one  there,  of  which  "  every  pro- 
fessor shall  declare  on  his  appointment  that 
he  is  a  dissenter  from  the  Established 
Church,"  though  with  the  still  odder  qualifi- 
cation that  he  believes  every  one  of  the 
principal  doctrines  of  the  Church  down  to 
infant  baptism.  The  only  one  not  specified 
is  episcopacy ;  but  there  is  no  prohibition  of 
behef  even  in  that  if  they  choose,  provided 
only  they  declare  that  they  dissent  from 
the  Church  with  liberty  to  believe  aU  its 
doctrines.  Probably  this  is  the  first  time 
in  history  that  schism  has  been  treated  as 
the  condition  for  enjoying  the  privileges  and 
endowments  of  a  Christian  society.  It  was 
always  defended  before  as  the  only  means 
of  retaining  orthodoxy.  These  people  are 
making  it  plainer  every  day  that  modern 
dissent  is  not  theological,  but  only  hatred 
of  the  Church.     [G.] 

TOUCHING  FOR  THE  EVIL  (See 
King's  Evil ;  Cramp-rings). 

TONSURE.  The  cutting  off  the  hair  of 
the  head  either  wholly  or  partially,  as  a 
sign  of  dedication  to  the  clerical  or  monastic 
life.  A  clerical  tonsure  was  made  necessary 
about  the  fifth  or  sixth  century.  No  men- 
tion is  made  of  it  before,  and  it  is  first 
spoken  of  with  decided  disapprobation. 

The  ancient  tonsure  of  the  Western  clergy 
by  no  means  consisted  in  shaven  crowns : 
this  was  expressly  forbidden  them,  lest,  as 
St.  Jerome  says  (lib.  iii.  in  Ezek.  c.  44), 
they  should  resemble  the  priests  of  Isis  and 
Serapis,  who  shaved  the  crowns  of  their 
heads.  But  the  ecclesiastical  tonsure  was 
nothing  more  than  polling  the  head,  and 
cutting  the  hair  to  a  moderate  degree. 
After  a  time  different  fashions  were  adopted 
by  the  clerical  tonsors,  and  something 
emblematical  was  discovered  in  the  manner 
in  which  the  scissors  were  directed.  The 
Eastern  clergy  were  accustomed  to  shave 
the  whole  of  the  head,  leaving  only  the 


TRACERY 

hair  on  the  hinder  part  untouched.  The 
Celtic  clergy,  including  the  British,  shaved 
all  the  hair  in  front  of  a  line  drawn  over  the 
top  of  the  head  from  ear  to  ear ;  whereas  the 
Italians  shaved  their  heads  according  to 
what  they  called  the  tonsure  of  St.  Peter, 
which  consisted  of  a  circle  of  hair  round  the 
shorn  top  of  the  head,  supposed  to  represent 
the  crown  of  thorns,  and  called  therefore  the 
coronal  tonsure.  The  earliest  representation 
of  this  is  in  a  sixth  century  mosaic  of  St. 
Apollinaris  at  Ravenna.  So  completely  was 
this  considered  a  party  badge,  that  the 
question  of  tonsure  was  one  of  the  gravest 
subjects  of  dispute  between  the  adherents  of 
Celtic  or  Scottish  usages  in  England  and  of 
the  Roman.  When  Wilfritb,  who  had  been 
brought  up  in  the  Scottish  school,  visited 
Gaul  and  became  converted  to  Roman 
fashions,  he  received  the  coronal  tonsure  at 
Lyons. — Hook's  Archbishops,  i.  xv. ;  Eddius. 
Vita  Wil/r. 

TRACERY.  The  ornamental  frame-work 
in  a  window,  or  in  a  compartment  of  panel- 
ling or  screen-work.  The  first  form  of 
tracery  was  doubtless  suggested  by  the 
pierced  circle  often  found  between  the 
heads  of  two  lancets,  and  connected  with 
them  by  a  single  hood. 

The  next  advance  was  to  combine  two 
such  pairs  and  put  another  circle  over 
them,  so  as  to  make  a  window  of  four 
(upright)  "  lights,"  with  two  small  circles 
over  them,  and  one  large  one  over  all,  under 
one  arch  which  was  generally  "  equilateral," 
or  such  as  would  contain  an  equilateral 
triangle.  Then  came  windows  of  three  and 
six  lights,  and  more,  up  to  nine,  as  at  Lin- 
coln, Carlisle,  Exeter,  and  now  St.  Alban's, 
with  circles  over  them,  of  which  various 
forms  may  be  seen  in  any  architectural 
books.  It  is  unsatisfactory  to  indicate 
tracery  in  pictures  by  mere  lines,  as  the 
thickness  of  the  tracery  bars  is  an  essential 
feature  of  the  construction,  and  mere  lines 
give  a  false  idea  of  the  effect,  and  they  look 
poor  without  foliation  or  cusps  (q.  v.). 
Some  of  the  finest  windows  would  appear 
impossible  to  construct  when  only  the  cen- 
tral lines  of  the  bars  are  shown.  We  have 
already  explained  the  difierences  between 
the  tracery  of  the  Early  or  Geometrical, 
and  the  Late  or  Flowing  Decorated,  and  the 
Perpendicular  styles  (See  also  Windows; 
and  Sharpe's  Decorated  Window  Tracery). 
And  the  term  is  not  confined  to  windows ; 
it  is  also  used  for  any  open  panelling  with 
ornamental  bars,  and  even  for  mere  sunk 
panelling  in  the  ends  of  stalls  and  such-like 
places,  and  sometimes  large  doors  are  so 
ornamented.     [G.] 

TRACT,  in  the  Roman  Missal,  is  an 
anthem,  generally  taken  from  the  Psalms, 
following,  and  sometimes  substituted  for, 


TRADITION 


74^ 


the  Gradual  (i.e.  the  anthem  after  the 
Epistle),  during  penitential  seasons,  as  the 
third  Sunday  in  Advent,  the  three  Sundays 
before  Lent,  Sundays,  Mondays,  Wednes- 
days, and  Fridays  in  Lent,  Easter  Saturdays, 
and  Easter  Even,  and  certain  holidaysv 
Cardinal  Bona  says  it  is  so  called,  "a 
trahendo:  quia  tractim  et  graviter,  et 
prolixo  descensu  cautatur,"  because  it  is 
sung  in  a  protracted  or  slow  manner. 

TRADITION.  Tradition  sometimes 
means  the  doctrine  held  by  Christians,  as 
distinguished  from  the  same  doctrine  written 
in  the  Bible.  It  is  also  used  as  an  equiva- 
lent to  "  custom "  as  in  the  34th  Article. 
Traditions  in  the  former  sense  may  be 
divided  into  those  which  have  been 
conmionly  maintained  in  some  particular 
age  only,  or  which  a  portion  of  the  Church 
has  maintained  without  separating  from  the 
rest:  and  those  which  the  great  body  of 
Christians  from  the  beginning  have  always 
held  to  be  articles  of  the  faith.  The  former 
class  of  tradition  may  be  certainly  true,  but 
the  ecclesiastical  authority  which  supports 
them  can  only  render  them  probable.  The 
latter  sort  of  traditions  afford  an  irresistible 
confirmation  of  the  doctrine  of  Scripture, 
and  a  certain  test  of  the  correctness  of 
Scripture  interpretation.  It  is  not  here 
meant  that  the  real  sense  of  Scripture  is 
obscure  in  any  points  of  faith,  so  that  it  is 
necessary  to  consult  previously  the  traditions 
and  judgments  of  the  universal  Church. 
Romanists  do  not  hold  that.  "  Our  assertion 
is  not  that  all  the  passages  of  Scripture  are 
so  obscure  that  in  order  to  explain  and  fix 
their  meaning  it  is  indispensable  to  recur 
to  a  judge.  We  say  that  there  are  some 
which  ignorance,  carelessness,  bad  reasoning, 
passion,  party  interest,  may  pervert,  and  in 
fact  may  have  perverted,  to  a  meaning 
contrary  to  sound  doctrine  (Card,  de  la 
Luzerne,  Diss,  sur  les  Eglises  (lath,  et  Prot. 
t.  i.  p.  59).  The  difference  between  the 
Anglo-Catholic  and  the  common  Roman 
Catholic  doctrine  of  tradition  is  this.  The 
former  only  admits  tradition  as  confirma- 
tory of  the  true  meaning  of  Scripture,  the 
latter  asserts  that  it  is  also  supplementary 
to  Scripture,  conveying  doctrines  which 
Scripture  has  omitted.  "We  hold,"  says 
the  writer  quoted  above  (torn  h.  p.  321), 
but  the  Church  of  England  denies,  "that 
unwritten  tradition  is  an  irrefragable  rule  of 
faith  in  two  -ways:  first  by  itself,  because 
there  are  truths  which  have  only  been 
given  to  the  Church  by  this  way  :  secondly, 
because  it  is  the  most  certain  interpreter 
of  the  Holy  Scripture,  and  the  infallible 
means  of  knowing  its  meaning  (See  Palmer's 
Treatise  on  tlie  Church,  ii.  44).     [H.] 

The  difference  between  traditionary  facts 
and  traditionary  doctrines    is    not  always 


742 


TKADITION 


sufficiently  otseived.  Traditioa  alone 
cannot  prove  a  doctrine  to  be  true,  or  an 
essential  part  of  Christianity.  All  that  it 
can  prove  is  that  the  doctrine  was  held 
more  or  less  generally,  according  to  the 
evidence,  so  far  back  as  the  time  to  which 
the  evidence  carries  it.  And  no  rules  can 
be  laid  down  as  to  the  evidence  that  is 
sufficient  to  prove  anything.  To  take  a 
doctrine  unquestioned  by  all  churchmen, 
the  propriety  of  infant  baptism:  hardly 
anybody  doubts  the  evidence  or  tradition 
that  it  was  practised  from  the  earliest  times. 
That  is  all  that  tradition  can  do  for  it.  But 
as  it  is  not  opposed  to  any  teaching  of  our 
Lord  or  the  Apostles,  but  rather  agree- 
able thereto  (Art.  27),  all  people,  except 
those  of  a  particular  sect,  take  that  to  be 
sufficient  to  establish  it.  On  the  other 
hand,  no  traditionary  evidence  of  opinions 
as  to  its  effect,  or  the  consequences  of  dying 
without  baptism,  can  be  properly  said  to  prove 
anything,  according  to  the  sixth  article : — 
"  whatsoever  is  not  read  in  Holy  Scripture, 
nor  may  be  proved  thereby,  is  not  to  be 
,  required  of  any  man  to  be  believed  as  an 
article  of  faith."  Tradition  of  facts  alone  is 
quite  another  thing,  and  there  is  an  un- 
reasonable tendency  nowadays  to  under- 
value it,  and  to  imagine  that  almost  any 
history  or  tradition  of  facts  not  intrinsically 
incredible  can  be  overborne  by  ingenious 
conjectures  of  probabilities.  Archbishop 
Whately's  Historic  Doubts  (about  the  history 
of  Napoleon  and  some  later  French  events) 
was  written  to  expose  the  absurdity  of  such 
conjectures;  for  he  showed  that  even  very 
recent  history  was  full  of  the  greatest  impro- 
babilities, and  apparently  quite  inconsistent 
with  the  then  present  state  of  Europe  ;  and  it 
now  appears  still  more  so.  Within  living 
memory  it  was  the  fashion  with  "  advanced  " 
scholars  to  believe  that  Niebuhrhad  success- 
fully rewritten  early  Eoman  history,  and  that 
Bunsen  and  others  had  expanded  Egyptian 
history  into  periods  of  enormous  length. 
Such  beliefs  have  all  vanished  again.  Hero- 
dotus has  been  in  effect  called  a  liar  in  still 
more  recent  times,  but  is  now  again  recog- 
nised as  the  father  of  history,  and  not  of 
lies,  where  he  professes  to  relate  facts. 

Dr.  Salmon,  in  his  recent  "  Introduction 
to  the  New  Testament,"  points  out  the  much 
greater  probability  of  the  primitive  traditions 
that  St.  Paul  did  write  the  Epistle  to  the 
Hebrews  and  that  the  Apocalypse  was 
written  in  the  time  of  Domitian,  than  of  any 
actual  or  possible  guesses,  from  what  the 
guessers  call  internal  evidence,  that  the 
Epistle  was  written  by  somebody  else,  and 
that  the  Apocalypse  was  revealed  as  early  as 
Nero,  or  before  the  destruction  of  Jerusalem. 
People  forget  the  immense  probability  of 
the  tradition  itself  being  true,  and  especially 


TRANSEPT 

people  who  have  not  the  least  hesitation  in 
imputing  forgery  to  every  written  tradition 
or  contemporanebus  history  which  they  do 
not  like.  They  think  if  they  can  make  out 
that  the  a  priori  or  internal  probabilities, 
from  style  or  anything  else,  are  what  they 
want,  the  business  is  done  :  whereas  those 
probabilities  are  themselves  always  doubtful 
and  disputed,  and  the  turn  of  a  probability 
is  worth  scarcely  anything  against  actual 
history  or  tradition  coming  close  up  to  the 
time  of  the  events.     [G.] 

TEADITIONS  OP  THE  CHURCH  (See 
Ceremony).  "  It  is  not  necessary  that  tra- 
ditions and  ceremonies  be  in  all  places  one, 
and  utterly  like ;  for  at  all  times  they 
have  been  divers,  and  may  be  changed 
according  to  the  diversities  of  countries, 
times,  and  men's  manners,  so  that  nothing 
be  ordained  against  God's  word.  Whoso- 
ever, through  his  private  judgment,  will- 
ingly and  purposely,  doth  openly  break  the 
traditions  and  ceremonies  of  the  Church, 
which  be  not  repugnant  to  the  word  of 
God,  and  be  ordained  and  approved  by 
common  authority,  ought  to  be  rebuked 
openly  (that  others  may  fear  to  do  the 
like),  as  he  that  offendeth  against  the  com- 
mon order  of  the  Church,  and  hurteth  the 
authority  of  the  magistrate,  and  woundeth 
the  consciences  of  the  weak  brethren. 

"  Every  particular  or  national  Chturch 
hath  authority  to  ordain,  change,  and 
abolish,  ceremonies  or  rites  of  the  Church 
ordained  only  by  man's  authority,  so  that 
all  things  be  done  to  e&iiying."— Article 
XXXIV. 

The  word  "tradition"  is  not  here  used 
in  the  same  sense  in  which  it  was  used  in 
the  explanation  of  the  sixth  Article.  It 
there  signified  unwritten  articles  of  faith, 
asserted  to  be  derived  from  Christ  and 
His  apostles :  in  this'  Article  it  means  cus- 
toms or  practices,  relative  to  the  external 
worship  of  God,  which  had  been  delivered 
down  from  former  times;  that  is,  in  the 
sixth  Article,  traditions  meant  traditional 
doctrines,  of  pretended  Divine  authority ; 
and  in  this  it  means  traditional  practices 
acknowledged  to  be  of  human  institution. 

TEADITOKS  {Traitors).  Persons  who, 
in  times  of  persecution,  delivered  the  sacred 
Scriptures  and  sacred  utensils  of  the  church, 
in  fact  anything  that  was  demanded  of 
them,  to  the  persecutors.  The  first  Council 
of  Aries  (can.  13),  which  was  held  immedi- 
ately after  the  Diocletian  persecution,  makes 
it  deposition  from  his  order  for  any  clergyman, 
who  could  be  convicted  by  his  public  acts  of 
this  crime,  either  of  betraying  the  Scriptures, 
or  any  of  the  holy  vessels,  or  the  names  of 
his  brethren. 

TRANSEPT.     1.  The  transverse  portion 


TRANSITION 

right  across  cruciform  cliurches.  2.  The 
northern  or  southern  end  of  them,  exclusive 
of  the  intervening  tower  or  space  (See 
CatliedroT). 

TRANSITION.  About  the  year  1145 
the  use  of  the  pointed  arch  was  introduced 
into  English  architecture,  and  with  this  so 
many  constructive  changes  in  the  fabric, 
that  though  Norman  decorations  were  long 
retained,  and  even  the  round  arch  was  used, 
except  in  the  more  important  constructive 
portions,  a  style  equally  distinct  from 
Norman  and  from  Early  EngUsh  was  the 
result,  and  this  style  is  called  Semi-Norman 
or  Transition.  Before  the  close  of  the  twelfth 
century,  the  round  arch  had  almost  entirely 
disappeared.and  the  Early  EngUsh,  or  Lancet, 
style  was  fully  developed  about  1190.  But 
all  the  changes  are  equally  called  Transitions. 

TRAiJSLATION.  I.  The  removal  of  a 
bishop  from  the  charge  of  one  diocese  to 
that  of  another,  in  which  case  the  bishop  in 
his  attestations  writes  "  anno  translationis 
nostra,"  not  "  anno  consecrationis  nostrse." 

II.  In  literature,  the  rendering  of  a  work 
from  the  original  into  another  language. 
All  the  scriptural  portions  of  the  Prayer 
Book  are  not  derived  from  the  translation 
in  common  use.  For  example,  the  Psalter 
is  from  the  great  English  Bible  set  forth 
and  used  in  the  time  of  Henry  VIII.  and 
Edward  VI.,  mainly  Coverdale's  which  he 
printed  in  1535.     It  was  reprinted  in  1838. 

in.  In  the  Roman  Church,  when  two 
festivals  of  a  certain  class  concur  on  the 
same  day  with  other  festivals  of  the  same  or 
similar  class,  the  celebration  of  one  or  other 
of  these  festivals  is  transferred  to  some 
future  day,  according  to  rules  which  are 
given  in  the  Breviary  and  Missal.  This  is 
caUed  a  translation. 

IV.  The  removal  of  a  body  from  one 
place  to  another.  Thus,  when  the  relics  of 
St.  Martin  were  removed  from  his  burial 
place  at  Cande  to  the  basilica  dedicated  to 
his  honour  at  Tours,  it  was  called  the  "  trans- 
lation "  of  St.  Martin,  and  the  fact  was  com- 
memorated in  a  festival  under  that  name. 
Edward,  king  of  the  West  Saxons,  murdered 
at  Corfe  Castle,  and  buried  without  any 
solemnity,  was  three  years  afterwards  "trans- 
lated "  to  Shaftesbury.     [H.] 

TRANSOM.  A  horizontal  mullion,  or 
cross-bar,  in  a  window,  or  in  panelling. 
The  transom  first  occurs  in  late  Decorated 
windows,  and  in  Perpendicular  windows  of 
large  size  it  is  of  universal  occurrence.  It 
was  probably  adopted  in  consequence  of  the 
attenuation  of  the  upright  mullions  which 
began  in  the  Late  Decorated  style. 

TRANSUBSTANTIATION.  This  word 
is  used  to  express  the  doctrine  held  by  the 
Church  of  Rome,  and  enforced  upon  all  her 
members  concerning  the  condition   of  the 


TRANSUBSTANTIATION         743 

consecrated  elements  in  the  Sacrament  of  the 
Eucharist.  It  is  held  that  while  the  accidents 
of  bread  and  wine  (colour,  taste,  smell,  &c.) 
remain — in  short  everything  that  indicates 
their  nature  and  substance — the  substance  of 
them  is  transmuted  into  the  very  substance 
of  the  natural  body  of  our  Saviour  Jesus 
Christ.  There  has  taken  place,  it  is  said,  a 
conversion  of  the  whole  substance  of  the 
bread  into  the  substance  of  His  Body,  and 
of  the  whole  substance  of  the  wine  into  the 
substance  of  His  Blood. 

The  doctrine  of  the  Church  of  Rome  which 
is  thus  expressed  has  been  emphatically 
rejected  by  the  Church  of  England!  At  the 
time  of  the  Reformation  no  point  of  dif- 
ference was  debated  at  greater  length,  or 
with  greater  warmth,  than  this.  The  judg- 
ment of  the  Church  of  England  is  expressed 
in  the  Twenty-eighth  Article  of  Religion. 
"  Transubstantiation  (or  the  change  of  the 
substance  of  bread  and  wine)  in  the  Supper 
of  the  Lord,  cannot  be  proved  by  holy  writ ; 
but  is  repugnant  to  the  plain  words  of 
Scripture,  overthroweth  the  nature  of  a 
Sacrament,  and  hath  given  occasion  to 
many  superstitions." 

The  idea  expressed  by  this  word  is  thus 
held  to  be  a  false  development,  and  per- 
version, of  the  views  concerning  the  con- 
dition and  use  of  the  sacred  elements  which 
prevailed  originally  in  the  Church  of  Christ. 
It  is  not  denied  that  the  consecrated  elements 
are  no  longer  to  be  considered  as  common 
bread  and  wine ;  nor  that  Christ,  as  Hooker 
says  (E.  P.  bk.  v.,  Ixvii.  11),  "doth  by  His 
own  divine  power  add  tothenatural  substance 
.  .  .  supernatural  efficacy,  which  additions  to 
the  nature  of  the  consecrated  elements  maketh 
them  that  unto  us  which  otherwise  they 
could  not  be."  But  to  draw  from  this  the 
inference  that  the  elements  have  undergone 
an  actual  physical  change  in  their  natural 
substance,  and  to  proceed  to  analyse  and 
define  this  change,  is  regarded  justly  as  a 
dangerous  and  presumptuous  speculation. 
The  consistency  of  the  doctrine  of  the  Church 
of  England  with  Holy  Scripture,  and  with 
the  language  used  by  early  Christian  writers, 
has  been  abundantly  vindicated.  It  is 
sufficient  to  refer  to  Bishop  Cosin's  Eistoria 
Transuhstantiationis  (cc.  v.-vii.);  Bishop 
Harold  Browne  on  the  Articles  (Art.  xxviii. 
pp.  681-695.  Ed.  ii.). 

The  word  transubstantiation  is  believed 
to  have  come  into  use  in  the  course  of  the 
11th  or  12th  century.  The  idea  which  it 
represents  had  been  the  subject  of  much 
debate  for  some  centuries  before.  Paschasius 
Badbert,  abbot  of  Corbie  (c.  840),  is  generally 
considered  as  the  first  vpriter  iDy  whom  it 
was  distinctly  enunciated.  On  the  other 
hand,  Bertram  (or  Ratramn),  also  a  monk 
of   Corbie    some    thirty    or    forty    years 


744 


TEAVEESE 


later,  wliose  book  was  censured  by  the 
Council  of  Trent,  maintained  the  absence  of 
any  corporal,  or  physical,  change  in  the 
sacred  elements.  At  the  Lateran  Council, 
1216,  under  Pojie  Innocent  III.,  the  word 
transubstantiation  was  sanctioned,  and  the 
doctrine  implied  by  it  enforced.  At  the 
Cormcil  of  Trent,  1551,  the  dogma  of  tran- 
substantiation was  formally  reaffirmed ;  and 
finally  it  was  inserted  as  an  article  of  faith 
in  the  creed  of  Pope  Pius  IV. 

These  innovations  on  the  doctrine  of  the 
primitive  Church,  thus  imhappily  sanctioned 
and  enforced,  have  created,  and  rendered 
permanent,  one  of  the  most  important  points 
of  difference  between  the  Church  of  England 
and  the  Church  of  Kome  (See  Real  Pre- 
sence).    [J.  G.  H.] 

TEAVEESE.  A  seat  of  state  with  a 
canopy,  formerly  placed  at  the  upper  end  of 
the  choir  in  the  royal  chapels,  and  tem- 
porarily in  cathedrals,  for  the  use  of  the 
sovereign. 

TEEASUEEE.  A  dignitary  formerly 
existing  in  all  cathedrals  and  collegiate 
churches  of  the  old  foundation  in  England, 
and  in  Ireland  and  Scotland  in  such  churches 
as  followed  the  English  model.  The  treasurer 
was  not  the  bursar,  but  rather  the  chief 
sacristan.  It  is  the  old  English  cyrcward, 
and  mediseval  perpetual  sacristan  (See  Sa- 
cristan). He  had  the  care  of  the  plate, 
vestments,  furniture,  necessaries  of  Divine 
service ;  the  control  of  the  sacristan  and 
inferior  officers,  of  the  bells,  and  the  general 
superintendence  of  the  fabric.  This  dignity 
was  founded  at  York  in  the  11th ;  at  Chi- 
chester, Lichfield,  Wells,  Hereford,  and  St. 
Paul's,  in  the  12th;  at  St.  David's  and 
Llandaff  in  the  13th  century.  But  at  the 
Eeformation  the  dignity  fell  into  disuse  in 
many  cathedrals.  Inmany  foreign  churches 
the  place  of  treasurer  was  discharged  by  a 
dignitary  called  a  sacristan ;  but  in  others, 
as  at  Glasgow,  and  the  royal  chapel,  Stir- 
ling, there  was  a  treasurer  and  a  sacristan, 
both  dignitaries.  At  York  it  was  abolished 
in  1547.  In  cathedrals  of  the  new  founda- 
tion, the  treasurer  is  merely  the  bursar; 
the  canons  taking  this  office  in  annual 
rotation. — Jebh;  Walcott's  Sac.  Arch.  p. 
688.     [H.] 

TEENT,  COUNCIL  OF  (See  Eoman 
Catholic  Church,  Popery,  Council  of  Trent). 
This  important  council  met  in  1545,  and 
was  dissolved  in  1563.  Its  nominal  period 
extended  over  eighteen  years,  but  its  actual 
sessions  occupied  less  than  five.  Protestants 
from  the  days  of  Luther  had  been  urgent 
for  the  convocation  of  a  free  synod.  They 
had  reiterated  the  demand  at  Nuremberg, 
and  Eatisbon  and  Spires.  There  were  in- 
deed on  both  sides  earnest  and  pious  persons 
who  were  anxious  that  the  questions  at  issue 


TEENT,  COUNCIL  OF 

should  be  settled  by  competent  authority. 
1'he  evil  lives  of  the  clergy,  and  the  general 
disorders  of  the  Church,  aiforded  another 
strong  reason  by  which  many  were  in-  j 
fluenced.  At  the  same  time,  the  endless  i 
extortions  of  the  Papal  chancery  had  raised  ' 
disputes  in  every  European  state,  which 
there  seemed  no  other  hope  of  allajring.  It;  ; 
was  the  great  object  of  the  jrape  and  his 
adherents  to  condemn  Lutheran  doctrine,  ! 
and  to  avoid  definition  on  points  disputed  in 
the  Eoman  Church.  Clement  VII,  had 
promised  that  a  general  council  should  be 
held  in  Italy  for  raising  subsidies  against  the 
Turks,  and  for  the  suppression  of  heresy, 
but  he  really  used  his  influence  to  prevent 
its  assembUng.  On  his  death  in  1534  his 
successor,  Paul  III.,  published  a  bull  of 
convocation.  Various  difficulties  however 
arose,  partly  on  account  of  the  proposed 
place  of  meeting,  and  partly  through  the 
war  between  the  emperor  and  the  kmg  of 
France,  and  interiwsed  a  delay  of  some 
years.  The  city  of  Trent  in  the  Tyrol,  on 
the  confines  of  Italy  and  Germany,  and  now 
in  the  dominions  of  Austria,  was  at  length 
selected,  the  summons  was  issued,  and  the 
council  was  opened  December  13,  1545. 
The  meeting  had  been  so  long  deferred,  thas 
when  a  few  ecclesiastics  and  others  assem- 
bled, it  was  hardly  believed  that  the  synod 
was  really  convened ;  and  the  importance 
of  the  movement  was  not  perceived  until 
somewhat  later. 

The  first  three  sessions  were  occupied  by 
preliminary  matters,  after  which  the  actual 
business  commenced.  The  constitution  of 
the  assembly,  as  well  as  the  form  of  pro- 
cedure, was  governed  by  arbitrary  rules. 
The  legates  presided  as  the  representatively- 
of  the  poije ;  who  also  appointed  the  secre- 
taiies  and  other  officers.  Bishops  alone  > 
were  allowed  to  vote,  but  an  exception  was 
made  in  the  case  of  certain  abbots  and 
generals  of  orders,  for  whose  admission  no 
precedent  could  however  be  alleged,  but 
such  as  would  be  equally  availing  for  all 
presbyters.  Proxies  were  generally  refused, 
although  some  were  allowed  by  the  sole 
authority  of  the  pope.  All  discussions  were 
confined  to  previous  congregations,  and  in; 
the  sessions  which  followed  there  was  no 
deliberation,  but  only  the  acceptance  or  - 
rejection  of  the  proposed  conclusions.  The 
judgments  of  the  council  were  embodied 
partly  in  decrees  which  profess  to  contain 
the  Catholic  doctrine  on  the  points  in  ques-' 
tion,  partly  in  canons  by  which  the  con- 
trary opinions  are  anathematized  as  here- 
tical. 

In  the  fourth  session,  which  began 
April  5,  1546,  somewhat  less  than  fifty 
bishops  being  present,  it  was  decreed  that 
the  canon  of  Scripture  includes  the  bxiks 


TRENT,  COUNCIL  OF 

commonly  called  apocryphal,  and  that 
tradition  is  to  be  received  as  of  equal  au- 
thority with  the  written  Word;  that  the 
Vulgate  is  to  be  taken  for  the  standard 
text,  and  no  interpretation  allowed  but 
such  as   the  Church   has  affixed.     Jn  the 

^ fifth  session  the  decree  on  original  sin  was 

,  passed ;  in  the  sixth,  that  on  justification ; 
and  in  the  seventh,  that  on  the  sacraments 
in  general,  and  baptism  and  confirmation 
in  particular.  In  the  eighth  session,  the 
removal  to  Bologna  was  appointed,  where 
the  two  following  sessions  were  held ;  but 
no  decrees  were  passed,  and  in  September, 
1547,  the  council  was  prorogued.  The 
translation  to  an  Italian  city  had  been  made 
under  a  bull  of  Paul  III.,  when  the  Gennan 
bishops  were  urgent  for  reformation,  and 
there  seemed  no  other  escape.  A  disease 
which  broke  out  at  Trent  was  the  alleged 
excuse.  In  1551  the  council  was  again 
convened  by  Julius  III.,  who  had  been 
present  at  a  former  period  as  legate.  The 
eleventh  and  twellth  sessions  were  spent  in 
formal  business;   in  the  thirteenth  the  sa- 

^  crament  of  the  Eucharist  was  treated ;  in  the 
fourteenth  the  sacraments  of  penance  and 
extreme  unction;  in  the  fifteenth,  a  safe 
conduct  was  granted  to  the  Protestants ; 
and  in  the  sixteenth,  which  was  held  in 
April,  1552,  the  prorogation  of  the  council 
for  two  years  was  decreed.  Paul  IV.  was, 
however,  resolutely  opposed  to  its  revival,  on 
the  ground  that  his  authority  was  ihigher 
than  that  of  a  synod,  which  was  therefore 
needless ;  and  by  the  threat  of  secular  reforma- 
tion he  deterred  some  princes  from  urging 
the  reassembling  of  the  council,  which  did 
not  take  place  till  January  1562,  when  the 
seventeenth  session  was  held  under  Pius  IV. 
In  the  eighteenth,  certain  of  the  Fathers 
were  appointed  to  prepare  an  mdex  of  pro- 
hibited books,  and  at  the  same  time  the 
safe-conduct  was  removed ;  in  the  eighteenth 
and  nineteenth  no  business  was  transacted ; 
in  the  twenty-first,  the  communion  under 
one  kind  was  enjoined  for  all,  except  the 
celebrant ;  in  the  twenty-second,  the  sacri- 

-  fice  of  the  mass  was  declared  to  be  a  true 
and  Catholic  doctrine ;  in  the  twenty-third, 
the  subject  handled  was  the  sacrament  of 
orders ;  in  the  twenty-fourth,  the  sacrament 
of  matrimony;  and  in  the  twenty-fifth,  de- 
crees were  passed  on  purgatory,  the  invo- 
cation of  saints,  the  worship  of  relics  and 
images,  indulgences,  fasting,  the  index  of 
prohibited  books,  the  catechism,  the  bre- 
viary, and  the  missaL  After  which,  the 
decrees  passed  under  Paul  III.  and  Julius 
III.  were  read,  and  the  council  was  dis- 
solved. 

In  reviewing  the  history  of  this  remark- 
able assembly,  it  is  impossible  to  overlook 
the  want   of  unity  both  in  purpose  and 


TRENT,  COUNCIL  OF 


745. 


opinion  among  its  members.  The  repre- 
sentatives of  the  German  emperor,  of  the 
kings  of  France  and  Spain,  of  the  duke 
of  Bavaria,  and  of  other  secular  princes,, 
urgently  demanded  the  reformation  of  the  • 
Church,  while  the  partisans  of  the  lloman 
court  were  desirous  only  to  suppress  Pro- 
testantism. There  were  none  but  Italians 
on  whom  the  pope  could  entirely  depend), 
for  even  the  Spanish  prelates  wished  his 
power  to  be  restrained,  and  that  of  other 
bishops  to  be  enlarged.  The  Germans  and 
French  demanded  the  restoration  of  the  cup, 
and  the  marriage  of  the  clergy,  while  the 
Spaniards,  who  opposed  them  on  these 
points,  were  united  with  them  on  some 
others  against  the  Roman  faction.  One 
great  party  was  urgent  that  the  later 
sessions  should  be  declared  a  continuation 
of  the  earlier,  while  another  vehemently 
opposed  the  declaration  ;  and  the  counoii 
never  ventured  to  rule  the  question  either 
way.  There  were  endless  conflicts  between  , 
the  bishops  and  the  monastic  orders,  and 
of  Franciscans  and  Dominicans,  with  each 
other.  Whether  the  Blessed  Virgin  was 
conceived  without  sin ;  what  is  the  true 
nature  of  transubstantiation ;  whether  Christ 
ofiered  Himself  in  the  holy  supper;  whether 
the  apostles  were  ordained  jiriests  at  that 
time  or  previously, — were  among  the  topics, 
of  vehement  contention.  On  the  subject  of 
the  great  doctrine  of  justification  by  faith„ 
the  members  of  the  council  were  far  from  - 
being  agreed,  and  it  is  beyond  denial  that 
some  of  them  held  the  Protestant  view. 
Even  the  scanty  number  who  ventured  to 
decide  on  the  canon  of  Scripture,  and  cm 
tradition,  were  at  variance  among  them- 
selves. Some  disputes  lasted  throughout' 
the  whole  period,  such  as  whether  the 
council  should  be  said  to  represent  the 
universal  Church;  whether  the  legates 
should  have  the  privilege  of  proposing  all 
matters  for  debate;  and  whether  doctrine 
should  precede  reformation.  The  question 
of  the  residence  of  bishops,  that  is,  whether 
it  is  binding  by  Divine  ordinance,  or  by  the 
law  of  the  Church,  in  which  important 
considerations  were  involved,  excited  long 
and  angry  conflicts.  Day  after  day,  through 
weeks  and  months  of  the  most  critical 
period,  the  dispute  was  renewed.  The 
legates  themselves  were  divided ;  and  atr 
one  time  the  dissolution  of  the  counciit 
seemed  inevitable. 

There  are  many  controverted  points  on 
which  the  council  gives  no  information,, 
and  they  are  the  very  questions  which  it 
was  most  important  to  decide.  No  one- 
can  learn  from  its  decrees,  for  instance, 
what  is  the  settled  doctrine  about  purga- 
tory, nor  in  what  due  veneration  for  images 
consists,  nor  which  is  the  sacramental  form 


746 


TEENT,  COUNCIL  OF 


in  penance,  or  matrimony,  nor  what  is  the 
nature  of  original  sin,  nor  what  is  the  pro- 
per definition  of  a  sacrament.  There  were 
some  subjects  debated  more  than  suffi- 
■ciently,  but  left  at  last  undecided ;  and 
there  were  some  positions  which  the  coun- 
cil could  not  renounce,  because  this  would 
have  contradicted  the  decrees  of  former 
popes  and  councils,  and  which  they  could 
.not  affirm,  because  they  were  opposed  by 
powerful  members  of  the  existing  Church. 

In  spite,  however,  of  the  imperfect  and 
•contradictory  statements  of  the  Fathers  of 
Trent,  they  had  no  hesitation'  in  pro- 
nouncing judgment  on  what  they  esteemed 
,  Lutheran  opinions.  We  can  indeed  find 
no  parallel  for  the  prodigality  of  their 
curses,  imless  we  go  back  to  the  days  of 
the  Donatists.  They  reach  not  only  to 
those  whom  the  Church  of  all  ages  has 
called  blessed,  but  to  many  also  of  the 
•doctors  most  esteemed  in  the  Eoman  com- 
munion itself.  If  any  one,  for  example, 
denies  that  the  works  of  justified  persons 
^re  truly  meritorious  of  eternal  life,  or 
"that  the  mass  is  a  true  and  propitiatory 
sacrifice,  or  that  the  custom  of  confessing 
privately  to  a  priest  has  existed  from  the 
apostolic  age,  or  that  tiie  Church  has  power 
to  change  an  institution  of  Christ,  he 
falls  under  the  imprecation  of  the  council. 
In  the  decree  of  the  last  session  on  the 
invocation  of  saints,  and  the  use  of  images 
and  relics,  an  anathema  is  pronounced,  not 
only  against  those  who  teach,  but  those 
who  even  think  differently.  And  yet  the 
;synod  which  spoke  with  so  much  boldness 
had  no  claim,  either  from  numbers  or 
character,  to  be  taken  as  representative  of 
the  Catholic  Church.  In  the  first  seven 
sessions  held  under  Paul  III.,  when  the 
ground  was  laid  for  maintaining  all  the 
errors  and  corruptions  of  the  Eoman  Church, 
less  than  sixty  bishops  were  present.  In 
the  thirteenth,  under  Julius  III.,  when 
transubstantiation  and  the  worship  of  the 
host  were  defined,  only  forty-five  bishops 
and  two  cardinals  were  assembled.  And  in 
-the  ninth  session  there  were  only  thirty- 
five  collected,  who  yet  presumed  to  take  the 
title  of  an  (Ecumenical  Council.  In  the 
later  sessions  held  under  Pius  IV.,  there 
was  a  greater  number  of  bishops  at  Trent ; 
but  the  chief  subjects  in  dispute  had  been 
ruled  in  the  earlier  periods  of  the  council, 
and  the  deficiency  of  numbers  was  not 
remedied  by  any  subsequent  confirmation. 
•Of  those  who  were  present,  the  chief  part 
were  Italians ;  some  were  bishops  of  incon- 
siderable sees,  and  some  mere  titulars. 
There  were  among  them  not  a  few  who 
subsisted  on  pensions  granted  by  the  ix)pe. 

The  council  was  in  no  sense  the  free  as- 
sembly to  which  Luther  and  others  had 


TEENT,  COUNCIL  OF 

appealed,  for  it  was  guided  throughout  by  * 
papal  influence ;  and,  as  the  Protestants 
complained  in  1546,  it  was  not  convened 
in  a  neutral  place,  while  the  pope,  who  was 
the  great  delinquent  on  trial,  was  allowed  to 
be  the  judge  in  his  own  cause.  There  were 
external  causes  at  work,  which  prevented 
the  freedom  of  debate.  At  the  very  time 
when  the  doctrine  of  justification  was  under 
review,  a  league  was  formed  between  the 
pope  and  the  emperor  for  putting  down  the 
Protestants;  and  while  the  council  was 
debating  the  bishop  of  Rome  was  sending 
his  contingent  of  troops.  In  the  council 
itself,  the  legates  assumed  unreasonable 
authority,  and  their  interruptions  were  the 
subject  of  continual  complaint.  During  the 
later  sessions,  the  Inquisition  was  in  full 
force,  and  there  were  persons  present  in  the 
council  who  had  been  suffisrers.  The  as- 
sembly was  over-borne  by  Italian  prelates. 
At  one  time,  when  very  important  subjects 
were  under  discussion,  there  were  no  more 
than  two  bishops  to  represent  the  Church  of 
France.  On  another  occasion,  forty  bishops 
were  sent  by  the  Eoman  court  for  the 
purpose  of  carrying  a  particular  point,  by 
outvoting  the  Spanish  bishops,  by  whom  it 
was  opposed.  We  find  the  ambassadors  of 
secular  princes  expressing  in  the  strongest 
language  their  sense  of  the  tryanny  under 
which  the  council  was  held,  and  by  which 
its  freedom  was  annihilated. 

No  one  who  considers  these  circum- 
stances can  wonder  that  the  beneficial  re- 
forms of  the  Church  did  not  result,  which 
had  been  so  long  expected  and  so  anxiously 
desired.  They  had  been  demanded,  but 
in  vain,  by  the  emperor,  and  other  great 
princes,  as  well  as  by  diets  and  other  as- 
semblies of  the  empire.  Even  as  late  as 
15C3,  the  French  ambassador  delivered  a 
list  of  thirty-four  articles  of  required  re- 
formation. After  the  twenty-second  ses- 
sion we  find  the  Imperialists  affirming  that 
none  of  the  desired  changes  had  been  pro- 
posed. And  just  before  the  close  of  the 
council,  the  Spanish  ambassador  came  to 
the  legates  with  a  written  complaint,  that 
the  principal  things  for  which  it  was  as- 
sembled had  been  omitted,  and  the  rest 
carried  with  precipitation.  The  French 
envoy  filled  the  letters  which  he  addressed 
to  his  court  with  similar  testimony.  What- 
ever beneficial  changes  in  the  administra- 
tion of  Church  affairs  seemed  to  have  been 
made,  were  neutralized  by  the  teims  in 
which  the  rights  of  the  see  of  Eome  were 
reserved,  and  which  were  vague  enough  to 
admit  every  abuse,  the  pope  himself  being 
constituted  judge  in  each  case,  and  possess- 
ing also  a  dispensing  power. 

The  last  session  was  brought  hastily  to 
a  close,  partly  through  the  dixdomatic  skill 


TRENT,  COUNCIL  OF 

of  the  legate  Morone;  but  chiefly  on  ac- 
count of  the  illness  of  the  pope,  because 
everybody  knew  that  if  he  died  during 
the  sitting  of  the  assembly,  a  schism  was 
inevitable. 

The  history  of  the  council  was  written, 
in  1619,  by  Sarpi,  and  forty  years  later  by 
Cardinal  Pallavicinl.  The  former  was  the 
most  learned  person  of  the  age,  a  states- 
man and  historian  as  well  as  a  divine ;  the 
latter  Is  chiefly  kno'svn  as  an  apologist  of 
the  court  and  Church  of  Rome.  His  work 
has  been  described  as  more  injurious  to 
papal  interests  than  that  of  fiis  prede- 
cessor ;  because  if  the  one  has  shown  how 
much  may  be  said  against  the  Council  of 
Trent,  the  other  has  made  it  equally  plain 
how  little  can  be  alleged  in  its  defence. 

The  decrees  of  the  council  were  signed 
by  only  255  members :  four  of  these  were 
legates  of  the  papal  see ;  two,  cardinals ; 
three,  patriarchs ;  twen,ty-five,  archbishops ; 
one  hundred  and  sixty-eight,  bishops ; 
thirty-nine,  deputies  of  absent  prelates ; 
seven,  abbots ;  and  seven  were  generals  of 
religious  orders.  The  Greek  Church  and 
the  English  Church  were  not  represented. 
It  was  subscribed  on  separate  schedules,  by 
the  ambassadors  of  the  sovereigns  who  still 
adhered  to  the  Eomish  system. 

The  following  are  the  anathemas  of  the 
council. 

I.  "The  sacred  oecumenical  and  general 
synod  of  Trent,  lawfully  assembled  in  the 
Holy  Ghost,  and  presided  over  by  the 
three  legates  of  the  apostolic  see,  having 
it  constantly  in  view  that,  by  the  removal 
of  errors,  the  gospel,  which,  promised  afore- 
time in  the  Holy  Scriptures  by  the  pro- 
jjhets,  Christ  himself  first  published  with 
his  own  mouth,  and  then  commanded  his 
apostles  to  preach  to  every  creature,  as  the 
source  of  all  saving  truth  and  instruction 
of  manners,  should  be  preserved  pure  in  the 
Church;  and  clearly  perceiving  that  this 
truth  and  this  instruction  are  contained 
in  written  books  and  unwritten  traditions, 
which  traditions  have  been  received  by  the 
apostles  from  the  mouth  of  Christ  himself, 
or  dictated  by  the  Holy  Spirit,  and  by 
the  apostles  handed  down  even  to  us,  re- 
ceives and  reverences,  conformably  to  the 
example  of  the  orthodox  Fathers,  with  the 
same  pious  regard  and  veneration,  all  the 
books  as  well  of  the  Old  as  of  the  New 
Testament —both  having  God  for  their 
author,  and  the  traditions  relating  both  to 
faith  and  practice,  inasmuch  as  tJiese  tradi- 
tions were  either  delivered  by  word  of  mouth, 
from,  Christ,  or  dictated  by  the  Holy 
Ghost,  and  preserved  by  uninterrupted 
succession  in  the  Catholic  Church.  The 
books  received  by  this  council  are,  of  the 
Old  Testament,  the  five  books  of  Moses,  viz.. 


TKENT,  COUNCIL  OF 


747 


Genesis,  &c.,  Joshua,  Judges,  Ruth,  four  of 
Kings,  two  of  Chronicles,  first  of  Esdras, 
second  of  Esdras,  called  Nehemias,  Tobias, 
Judith,  Esther,  Job,  Psalms  of  David, 
consisting  of  150,  Proverbs,  Ecclesiastes, 
Cantica,  Wisdom,  Ecclesiasticus,  Isaiah, 
Jeremiah,  with  Baruch,  Ezekiel,  Daniel, 
twelve  minor  prophets,  viz.,  Hosca,  &c., 
the  first  and  second  of  Maccabees.  Of 
the  New  Testament,  the  four  Gospels,  the 
Acts  of  the  Apostles,  the  Epistle  of  St. 
Paul  the  Apostle  to  the  Komatis,  two  to 
the  Corinthians,  one  to  the  Galatians,  one 
to  the  Ephesians,  one  to  the  Philippians, 
one  to  the  Colossians,  two  to  the  Thcs- 
salonians,  two  to  Timothy,  one  to  Titus, 
one  to  Philemon,  one  to  the  Hebrews,  the 
Epistle  catholic  of  St.  James,  the  two  Epis- 
tles of  St.  Peter,  the  three  Epistles  of  St. 
John,  the  Epistle  of  St.  Jude,  and  the 
Revelations  of  St.  John. 

Whosoever  shall  not  receive  these  books, 
entire  with  all  their  parts  (i.e.  the  Apo- 
crypha as  well  as  the  canonical  books),  as 
they  are  used  to  be  read  in  the  (Roman) 
Catholic  Church,  and  are  contained  in  the 
ancient  Vulgate  Latin  edition,  for  sacred 
and  canonical,  and  shall  knowingly  and 
wilfully  contenm  the  aforesaid  traditions : 
let  him  be  accursed  (See  Bible,  Scripture, 
Apocrypha). 

II.  Moreover,  in  order  to  repress  the 
arrogant  and  self-suflScient,  the  council 
decrees,  that  no  one,  relying  on  his  own 
wisdom,  shall  presume  to  pervert  and  in- 
terpret Holy  Scripture  to  his  own  sense, 
in  matters  of  faith  and  manners,  pertain- 
ing to  the  edification  of  Christian  doctrine, 
contrary  to  the  sense  which  hath  been  and 
is  maintained  by  the  holy  mother  Church, 
to  whom  it  belongs  to  judge  of  the  true 
meaning  and  interpretation  of  the  Holy 
Scriptures,  or  contrary  to  the  unanimous 
consent  of  the  Fathers,  even  if  such  inter- 
pretations should  never  be  made  public 
(See  Fathers  and  Tradition). 

III.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the  sacra- 
ments of  the  New  Law  were  not  all  in- 
stituted by  Jesus  Christ  our  Lord,  or  that 
they  are  more  or  less  in  number  than  seven ; 
that  is  to  say,  baptism,  confirmation,  the 
Lord's  supper,  penance,  extreme  unction, 
orders,  and  matrimony ;  or  that  any  one  of 
these  seven  is  not  truly  and  properly  a 
sacrament :  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Seven 
Sacraments). 

IV.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  by  the 
sacraments  of  the  New  Law,  grace  is  not 
conferred  by  the  mere  performance  of  the  act, 
but  that  faith  alone  in  the  Divine  promise 
is  sufficient  to  obtain  grace :  let  him  be  ac- 
cursed (See  Opus  Operatum). 

V.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  it  is  not 
requisite  that  the  ministers,  when  celebrating 


748 


TRENT,  COUNCIL  OF 


the  sacraments,  should  have,  at  least,  tlie 
intention  of  doing  that  which  the  Church 
doeth :  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Intention, 
Priests'). 

VI.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the  free 
■will  of  man,  after  the  sin  of  Adam,  was  lost 
and  extinguished :  let  him  be  accursed  (See 
Free  WilV). 

VII.  The  formal  cause  of  justiBcation  is 
the  righteousness  of  God :  not  that  where- 
by he  is  himself  righteous,  but  that  where- 
by he  maketh  us  righteous;  that  with 
which  we,  being  by  him  endowed,  are  re- 
newed in  the  spirit  of  our  mind,  and  are 
not  only  accounted,  but  are  truly  called, 
and  are  righteous,  each  of  us  receiving  into 
himself  righteousness,  according  to  the 
measure  whereby  the  Spirit  divideth  to 
every  man  severally  as  he  will,  and  accord- 
ing to  every  man's  disposition  and  co-opera- 
tion (See  Hanctificaticm'). 

VIII.  "Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the  un- 
godly is  justified  by  faiih  alone,  so  as  to 
imderstand  that  nothing  else  is  required 
to  co-operate  in  obtaining  the  grace  of  justi- 
fication ;  and  that  it  is  by  no  means  neces- 
sary that  he  should  be  prepared  and  disposed 
by  the  motion  of  his  own  will :  let  him  be 
accursed  (See  Justification). 

IX.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  in  the 
mass  there  is  not  a  true  and  proper  sacrifice 
offered  up  to  God,  and  that  the  offering 
up  is  no  more  than  the  giving  us  Christ  to 
eat :  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Satisfaction, 
Romish). 

X.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  by  these 
words,  "  This  do  in  remembrance  of  me," 
Christ  did  not  ordain  the  apostles,  priests, 
or  that  he  did  not  appoint  that  they  and 
other  priests  should  oBer  up  his  body  and 
blood :  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Orders). 

XI.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the  sa- 
crifice of  the  mass  is  one  only  of  praise  and 
thanksgiving,  or  a  bare  commemoration  of 
the  sacrifice  made  on  the  cross,  but  not  a 
propitiatory  sacrifice,  or  that  it  is  profitable 
only  to  the  partaker,  and  that  it  ought  not 
to  be  offered  up  for  the  quick  and  the  dead 
for  sins,  pains,  satisfactions,  and  other  ne- 
cessities :  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Mass, 
Sacrifice  of). 

XII.  Whosoever  shall  deny,  that  in  the 
most  holy  sacrament  of  the  eucharist,  the 
body  and  blood,  together  with  the  soul  and 
Divinity,  of  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ,  and, 
consequently,  the  whole  of  Christ,  are  truly, 
really,  and  substantially  contained;  but 
shall  say  that  they  are  there  only  symboli- 
cally, figuratively,  or  virtually :  let  him  be 
accursed  (See  Real  Presence  and  Iransuh- 
stantiation). 

XIII.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  in  the 
holy  sacrament  of  the  eucharist,  the  sub- 
stance of  bread  and  wine  remains,  together 


TEENT,  COUNCIL  OF 

with  the  substance  of  the  body  and  blooil 
of  our  Lord  Jesus  Christ,  and  shall  deny 
that  wonderful  and  singular  change  of  the 
whole  substance  of  the  bread  into  the  body, 
and  of  the  whole  substance  of  the  wine  into 
the  blood,  the  species  of  bread  and  wine 
still  remaining,  which  change  the  (Roman) 
Catholic  Church  very  fitly  calleth  Tran- 
substantiation :  let  him  be  accursed  (See 
Transubstantiation). 

XIV.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  Christ 
exhibited  in  the  eucharist  is  only  spirit- 
ually eaten,  and  not  also  sacramentaUy 
and  really ;  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Et<r- 
charist). 

XV.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  in  the 
most  holy  sacrament  of  the  eucharist,  Christ,, 
the  only-begotten  Son  of  God,  is  not  to  be 
adored  with  the  worship  called  Latria  even 
outwardly;  nor  honoured  by  a  peculiar 
festival,  nor  solemnly  carried  about  in  pro- 
cessions, according  to  the  praiseworthy  and 
universal  rite  and  usage  of  the  holy  Church, 
nor  exposed  publicly  to  the  people  to  be 
worshipped,  and  that  its  worshippers  are 
idolaters :  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Corpus 
Christi). 

XVI.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the  holy 
eucharist  ought  not  to  be  reserved  in  a 
sacred  place,  but  is  immediately  after  con- 
secration necessarily  to  be  distributed  to 
those  present,  or  that  it  ought  not  to  be 
carried  in  a  respectful  maimer  to  the  sick : 
let  him  be  accursed  (See  Elevation  of  the 
Host). 

XVII.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  it  is 
the  commandment  of  God,  or  necessary  to 
salvation,  that  all  and  every  faithful  Chris- 
tian should  receive  the  most  holy  sacra- 
ment of  the  eucharist,  under  both  kinds : 
let  him  be  accursed  (See  Communion  in 
One  Kind). 

XVIII.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the 
holy  Catholic  Church  hath  not  been  moved 
by  just  cause  and  reason  to  administer  the 
bread  only  to  the  laity,  and  even  to  the 
clergy  not  officiating,  or  that  it  is  in  error 
in  so  doing :  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Cup). 

XIX.  "Whosoever  shall  deny,  that  the 
whole  of  Christ,  the  source  and  author 
of  all  grace,  is  received  in  the  bread,  be- 
cause, as  some  falsely  affirm,  according  to 
Christ's  own  institution,  he  is  not  re- 
ceived under  one  and  each  kind :  let  him  bo 
accursed  (See  Communion  in  One  Kind). 

XX.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the  mass 
ought  to  be  performed  only  in  the  vulgar 
tongue :  let  him  be  accursed  (See  Liturgy). 

XXI.  The  Catholic  Church,  instructed  by 
the  Holy  Ghost,  and  in  conlbrmity  to  the 
Holy  Scriptures,  and  the  ancient  tradition 
of  the  Fathers,  hath  taught  in  its  sacred 
councils,  and,  lastly,  in  this  oscumenical 
sjTiodi  that  there  is  a  purgatory,  and  that 


TRENT,  COUNCIL  OF 

the  souls  detained  therein  are  assisted  by 
the  prayers  of  the  faithful,  and  more  especi- 
ally by  the  acceptable  sacrifice  of  the  altar 
{See  Purgatory). 

XXII.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  after 
receiving  the  grace  of  justification,  any  peni- 
tent sinner  hath  his  offence  so  remitted,  and 
his  obnoxiousness  to  eternal  punishment  so 
blotted  out,  as  to  render  him  no  longer  ob- 
noxious to  temporal  punishment,  to  be 
undergone  either  in  this  world  or  in  the 
future  in  purgatory,  before  an  entrance  can 
be  opened  to  the  kingdom  of  heaven:  let 
him  accursed  (See  Purgatory). 

XXIII.  This  holy  synod  enjoins  all  bi- 
shops and  others  who  undertake  the  office 
of  teaching,  to  instruct  the  faithful,  that 
the  saints  who  reign  together  with  Christ 
offer  up  their  prayers  to  God  for  men,  that 
it  is  good  and  profitable  to  invoke  them  in 
a  supplicating  manner,  and  that,  in  order  to 
procure  benefit  from  God  through  his  Son 
Jesus  Christ  our  Lord,  who  is  our  only 
Kedeemer  and  Saviour,  we  should  have 
recourse  to  their  prayers,  help,  and  assis- 
tance ;  and  that  those  persons  hold  impious 
opinions  who  deny  that  the  saints  enjoying 
eternal  happiness  in  heaven  are  to  be  in- 
voked ;  or  who  affirm,  that  the  saints  do  not 
pray  for  men,  or  that  the  invoking  them 
that  they  may  pray  ever  for  every  one  of 
us  in  particular,  is  idolatry,  or  is  repugnant 
to  the  word  of  God,  and  contrary  to  the 
honour  of  the  one  Mediator  between  God 
and  men,  Jesus  Christ,  or  that  it  is  foolish 
to  supplicate  orally  or  mentally  those  who 
reign  in  heaven  (See  Invocation  of  Saints). 

XXIV.  Also  the  bodies  of  the  holy  mar- 
tyrs and  others  living  with  Christ,  having 
been  lively  members  of  Christ  and  temples 
of  the  Holy  Ghost,  and  to  be  raised  again 
by  him  to  eternal  life  and  glory,  are  to  be 
reverenced  by  the  faithful,  as  by  them  many 
benefits  are  bestowed  by  God  on  men ;  so 
that  they  who  affirm  that  reverence  and 
honour  are  not  due  to  the  reliques  of  saints, 
or  that  it  is  useless  for  the  faithful  to  honour 
them  or  other  sacred  monuments,  and  a 
vain  tiling  to  celebrate  the  memory  of  the 
saints,  for  the  purpose  of  obtaining  their 
assistance,  are  wholly  to  be  condemned,  as 
the  Church  hath  before  condemned  and  now 
condemns  them.  The  images  of  Christ, 
and  of  the  Virgin  Mother  of  God,  and  of 
the  other  saints,  are  to  be  set  up  and  re- 
tained, especially  in  churches,  and  due 
honour  and  reverence  to  be  paid  unto  them 
(See  Image  Worship,  Mariolatry,  and 
Belies). 

XXV.  Since  the  power  of  granting  in- 
dulgences hath  been  bestowed  by  Christ 
upon  the  Church,  and  such  power  thus 
Divinely  imparted  hath  been  exercised  by 
her  even  in  the  earliest  times;  this  holy 


TRENT,  COUNCIL  OF 


749 


synod  teaches  and  enjoins  that  the  use  of 
indulgences,  as  very  salutary  to  Chiistian 
people,  and  approved  of  by  the  sacred 
councils,  be  retained  in  the  Church,  and 
pronounces  an  anathema  on  such  as  shall 
afiirm  them  to  be  useless,  or  deny  the 
ixjwer  of  granting  them  to  be  in  the  Church 
(See  Indvlgenees). 

XXVI.  The  holy  synod  exhorts  and 
adjures  all  pastors,  by  the  coming  of  our 
Lord  and  Saviour,  that  as  good  soldiers 
they  enjoin  the  faithful  to  observe  all 
things  which  the  holy  Roman  Church,  the 
mother  and  mistress  of  all  Churches,  hath 
enacted,  as  well  as  such  things  as  have 
been  enacted  by  this  and  other  oecumenical 
councils  (See  Church  of  Rome). 

XXVII.  The  chief  pontiffs,  by  virtue  of 
the  supreme  authority  given  them  in  the 
universal  Church,  have  justly  assumed  the 
power  of  reserving  some  graver  criminal 
causes  to  their  own  peculiar  judgment 
(See  Supremacy,  PapaT). 

XXVIII.  The  more  weighty  criminal 
charges  against  bishops  which  deserve  de- 
position and  deprivation  may  be  judged  and 
determined  only  by  the  supreme  Roman 
pontiff  (See  Pope). 

XXIX.  This  holy  synod  enjoins  all  pa- 
triarchs, primates,  archbishops,  bishops,  and 
all  others  who,  by  right  or  custom,  ought  to 
assist  at  a  provincial  council,  that  in  the 
first  provincial  synod  that  may  be  holden 
after  the  conclusion  of  the  present  council, 
they  do  openly  receive  all  and  each  of  the 
things  which  have  been  defined  and  enacted 
by  this  holy  synod;  also  that  they  do 
promise  and  profess  true  obedience  to  the 
supreme  Roman  pontiff,  and  at  the  same 
time  publicly  detest  and  anathematize  all 
heresies  condemned  by  the  sacred  canons, 
the  general  councils,  and  especially  by  this 
present  synod  (See  Popery). 

XXX.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the 
clergy  in  holy  orders,  or  regulars  having 
made  a  solemn  profession  of  chastity,  may 
contract  marriage,  and  that  a  marriage  so 
contracted  is  valid,  notwithstanding  the 
ecclesiastical  law  or  vow;  and  that  to 
maintain  the  contrary  is  nothing  else  than 
to  condemn  matrimony,  and  that  all  may 
contract  marriage  who  do  not  feel  them- 
selves to  have  the  gift  of  continence,  even 
though  they  should  have  made  a  vow  of 
it:  let  him  be  accursed;  since  God  denies 
it  not  to  such  as  rightly  ask  it,  nor  will  he 
suffer  us  to  be  tempted  above  what  we  are 
able  (See  Odibacy). 

XXXI.  Whosoever  shall  say,  that  the 
state  of  matrimony  is  to  be  preferred  to  the 
state  of  virginity  or  single  life,  and  that  it 
is  not  better  or  more  blessed  to  continue  in 
virginity  or  single  life :  let  him  bo  accursed 
(See  Matrimony). 


750 


TKENTAL 


TEENTAL  (Lat.  triginta,  softened  ia 
Ital.  to  trenta).  A  service  of  thirty  masses 
for  the  dead,  usually  celebrated  on  as  many 
different  days. 

TRICINALE.  "A  round  ball  with  a 
screw  coin  for  the  water  of  mixture,"  at 
the  holy  communion  in  Bishop  Andrewes's 
chapel,  and  in  Canterbury  cathedral. — Can- 
terhury's  Dom.  1646,  and  Neale's  Sist.  of 
the  Puritans,  vol.  li.  pp.  223,  224. 

TKIFORIUM.  Any  passage  in  the  walls 
of  a  church,  but  generally  restricted  in  its 
use  to  the  passage  immediately  over  the 
arches  of  the  great  arcade,  and  usually,  in 
Norman  and  Early  English,  marked  by  an 
arcade  of  its  own.  It  is,  in  fact,  the  opened 
front  of  the  gallery  or  space  between  the 
stone  vault  of  the  aisle  and  the  wooden 
roof  above  it.  In  Norman  churches  the 
oi^enings  were  generally  plain  wide  arches, 
one  to  each  bay,  or  "severy,"  as  in  the 
remaining  Norman  parts  of  St.  Alban's  and 
Norwich ;  or  double  or  treble,  as  at  Peter- 
borough. In  Early  English  the  triforium 
consisted  of  unglazed  windows,  generally  in 
pairs  or  threes,  and  in  Early  Decorated  still 
more  so.  It  was  then  that  the  triforia 
attained  their  greatest  beauty  at  Salisbury 
and  Westminster,  and  rather  later  at  Ely 
and  Lincoln,  and  the  nave  of  Lichfield. 
Later  in  the  Decorated  style,  they  began  to 
close  up  and  to  sink  int<5  pannelling,  with  a 
mere  dark  space  behind,  as  in  the  nave  of 
York  and  Worcester.  At  St.  Alban's  both 
the  Early  English  and  the  Decorated  tri- 
foria are  very  fine  blank  arcades,  with  only 
a  passage  behind  them.  In  the  Perpen- 
dicular style,  the  triforiimi  vanished  al- 
together, and  the  tall  and  monotonous 
clearstory  windows  come  down  nearly  to 
the  nave  arches,  sometimes  with  a  blank 
portion  under  a  transom  across  the  windows, 
and  sometimes  without,  as  at  Bath.  The 
efifect  of  this  is  very  inferior  to  the  older 
arrangements  with  the  height  divided  into 
three  stories,  each  complete  and  beautiful  in 
itself.     [G.] 

TRINITY.  The  first  of  the  Thirty-nine 
Articles  is,  "  There  is  but  one  living  and 
true  God,  everlasting,  without  body,  parts, 
or  passions :  of  infinite  power,  wisdom,  and 
goodness;  the  Maker  and  Preserver  of  all 
things,  both  visible  and  invisible.  And  in 
unity  of  this  Godhead  there  be  three  persons, 
of  one  substance,  power,  and  eternity ;  the 
Father,  the  Son,  and  the  Holy  Ghost." 

The  credendum  of  the  Athanasian  Creed 
begins,  "The  Catholic  faith  is  this;  That 
we  worship  one  God  in  Trinity,  and  Trinity 
in  Unity,  neither  confounding  the  persons 
nor  dividing  the  substance."  The  Niceue 
Creed  equally  affirms  the  Trinity.  The 
mystery  of  the  Trinity  in  Unity  is  taught 
by  revelation — not  by  reason  ;  although  it 


TRINITY 

is  not  in  contradiction  to  reason,  rightly 
exercised,  nor  more  unintelligible  than  many 
of  the  "  things  hard  to  be  understood "  in 
Holy  Scripture.  A  plurality  in  the  God- 
head is  indicated  by  the  language  of  the- 
very  earliest  revelations ;  which  pliu-ality 
is  plainly  expressed  under  the  Gospel  dis- 
pensation— a  sacred  Three  being  enumerated 
by  mutual  relation  in  the  form  of  baptism, 
and  by  name  in  the  apostolic  benediction ; 
which  Three  are  also  frequently  mentioned 
together  elsewhere,  though  not  in  terms  so 
clear. 

I.  The  doctrine  may  perhaps  be  gleaned 
as  much  from  the  economy  of  creation,  as 
from  that  of  redemption ;  and  here  it  may 
be  observed,  that  in  the  very  commence- 
ment of  the  sacred  history,  the  Deity  is- 
mentioned  under  a  term  of  plural  signifi- 
cation; and  when  man,  the  more  eminent 
work,  is  to  be  made,  and  is  afterwards 
spoken  of,  a  Divine  council  seems  implied : 
"  Let  us  make  man,"  &c.,  "  the  man  is  be- 
come as  one  of  us  !  "  The  word  ?li?S,  in 
its  singular  form  is  rarely  used,  only  (in 
imitation  of  the  Aramaic  usage)  in  poetry, 
and    later    Hebrew.      But    the    plural    of 

majesty,  C3''h7^.,  occurs  more  than  two 
thousand  times. 

Elohim,  in  the  plural,  was  the  first  term 
used  in  the  Divine  revelation,  and  it  seems 
intended  to  indicate  that  plurality — the  holy 
Trinity — afterwards  more  plainly  revealed. 
And  it  is  to  be  noticed,  that  by  this  word 
{Elohim)  was  the  earliest  revelation  made 
to  man.  In  this  was  the  faith  of  the 
patriarchs  expressed,  as  particularly  in  Gen. 
xxviii.  20-22 ;  and  by  this  name  God  ex- 
pressly declares  he  appeared  unto  them, 
when  by  his  "  name  Jehovah  "  he  was  "  not 
known"  (Ex.  vi.  3).  Indeed  this  latter 
term  seems  for  a  time  to  have  been  used 
less  as  a  name  than  as  a  character  of  the 
Elohim,  since  it  was  subsequently  that  it 
was  announced  as  the  "  name  " — I  AM — 
by  which  the  Divine  plurality  was  to  be 
known  in  unity  (niri))  (Ex.  iii.  14 ; 
vi.  2).  The  translation  of  Jehovah  by 
Adonai  (or  Lords)  is  also  remarkable ;  with 
the  coincidence  to  be  found  in  the  mode 
adopted  by  the  heathen,  of  spealdng  of  their- 
gods ;  as  in  the  name  of  Baalim  for  Baal 
(Judges  ii.  11 ;  Hosea  xi.  2). 

That  Elohim  implies  plurality  seems- 
evident,  from  the  construction  of  such  a 
passage  as  Gen.  xx.  13,  where  it  is  said, 
"when  they,  Elohim,  caused  me  to  wan- 
der." Again  (xxxv.  7),  when  "they  ap- 
peared unto  him,"  at  Bethel.  And  (Josh, 
xxiv.  19)  "  the  Elohim  are  holy."  In  Ps. 
Mil.  11,  the  Elohim  are  called  "judges;"" 
in  Ps.  cxlix.  2;  Isa.  xUv.  2,  and  liv.  5, 
"  makers  "  and  "  kings ; "  in  Ecol.  xii.  1, 


TEINITY 

"  creators ; "  and  in  Jer.  xxiii.  3G,  "  the 
living  Grods."  Other  places  are  mentioned 
by  Parkhurst ;  as  Gen.  xxxi.  53 ;  Deut.  iv. 
7 ;  V.  23,  or  26  ;  1  Sam.  iv.  8 ;  2  Sam.  vii. 
23  ;  Isa.  vi.  8 ;  Jer.  x.  10,  &c. 

In  perfect  accordance  with  this  is  the 
first  great  commandment  given  from  Mount 
Sinai :  "  I  am  the  Lord  thy  God  "  (Jeliovali 
Eloliim),  thou  "shalt  have  no  other  gods 
hefore  me  ; "  more  plainly  set  forth  in  the 
baptismal  "name" — the  Father,  the  Son, 
and  the  Holy  Ghost,  a  "  holy,  blessed,  and 
glorious  Trinity,"  in  inseparable  Unity,  and 
perfect  co-equality,  as  may  be  most  safely 
concluded,  from  the  various  passages  in 
which  the  sacred  Three  are  mentioned  in 
diflferent  order — the  Father  first,  in  St. 
Matt,  xxviii.  19, — the  Son  first,  in  2  Cor. 
xiii.  14, — and  the  Holy  Ghost  first,  in  1 
Cor.  xii.  4-6  ;  Eph.  iv.  4-6,  and  St.  Luke 
i.  35. 

The  laws  and  ordinances  of  the  Jews 
were  peculiarly  adapted  to  guard  the  pure 
worship  against  heathen  idolatry ;  there- 
fore, when  the  legislator,  in  speaking  of 
God,  uses  a  term  implying  plurality,  which 
he  does,  with  verbs  and  persons  singular, 
above  thirty  times,  this,  too,  in  the  Deca- 
logue, and  in  the  repetition  of  laws,  and 
frequently  prefaced  by  an  address,  de- 
manding attention, — "  Hear,  0  Israel !  " 
"  Thus  saith  the  Lord !  "  it  could  not  but 
be  that  plvuality  in  the  Godhead  was  in- 
tended to  be  announced.  This  is  strongly 
corroborated  by  such  expressions  as  "  holy 
God,"  "  thy  Creators,"  being  used  by  Joshua 
and  Solomon;  the  one  an  eminent  type  of 
Christ,  the  other  inspired  with  learning 
in  an  extraordinary  degree  (See  Bishop 
Huntingford's  Thovghts  on  the  Trinity, 
xxii.,  xxiii.).  And  we  may  be  rather  con- 
firmed in  the  opinion,  by  the  futile  attempts 
of  the  Jewish  Rabbins  to  make  tolerable 
sense  of  the  peculiar  phraseology  adopted, 
while  denying  the  imphcation  of  a  plu- 
rality. 

II.  This  wonderful  truth  seems  referred 
to,  and  corroborated  by,  the  introduction  to 
St.  John's  Gospel ;  which  declares  that  the 
"  Word  was  in  the  beginning  with  God. 
Again,  each  of  the  sacred  Three  is  noticed 
as  acting  separately  in  the  work.  With 
respect  to  the  Father  this  is  clear  from 
innumerable  passages,  in  which  the  Lord 
God  is  mentioned  as  the  Creator  (unless  in 
such  a  Trinity  be  implied,  which  then 
shortly  decides  the  point  at  issue).  Of  the 
Son  it  is  said,  "  all  things  were  made  by 
him ; "  and  expressly,  "  without  him  was  not 
anything  made  thatwasmade"  (St.  John  i.  3; 
Col.  i.  16).  And  of  the  Holy  Spirit,  that  by 
him  are  made  and  created  both  man  and  beast 
and  all  things  (Gen.  i.  2 ;  Job.  xxxiii.  4 ;  Ps. 
civ.  30).    Thus  is  that  passage  intelligible, 


TRINITY  SUNDAY 


751 


"  By  the  word  of  the  Lord  were  the  heavens 
made  :  and  all  the  host  of  them  by  the 
breath  of  his  mouth  "  (Ps.  xxxiii.  6).  The- 
mode  of  operation  in  the  work  of  redemp- 
tion has  been  before  noticed.  To  all  these 
may  be  added,  that  the  sacred  Three  are 
mentioned  equally  as  sending  and  instructing" 
the  prophets  and  teachers  (Jer.  vii.  25 ; 
St.  Matt.  ix.  38 :  x.  5 ;  Acts  xxvi.  16-18 ;  Isa. 
xlviii.  16 ;  Acts  xiii.  2,  4 :  xx.  28), — and 
equally  speaking  by  them  (Heb.  i.  1 ;  2  Cor. 
xiii.  3 ;  St.  Mark  xiii.  11).  Each,  too, 
gives  life — -raises  the  dead — and  is  joined  in 
the  form  of  baptism,  and  Christian  benedic- 
tion. The  formula  given  and  repeated  in 
the  New  Testament,  "  Go  ye  ...  in  the 
name  of  the  Father,  and  of  the  Son,  and  of 
the  Holy  Ghost,"  is  in  itself  sufficient  for  a 
believer  in  the  revelation  of  God. 

The  word  "  Trinity,"  being  a  Latin  word, 
does  not  occur  in  Holy  Scripture ;  nor  does 
the  word  "  Unity,"  as  applied  to  -the  Deity. 
But  neither  do  the  words  "  omnipresence  " 
and  "  omniscience ; "  and  as  the  use  of  these 
has  never  been  objected  to  in  speaking  of 
the  attributes  of  Him  who  is  everywhere 
present,  and  "  knoweth  all  things,"  so  may 
the  others  be  used  with  equal  propriety  to 
express  the  distinct  existence  of  Father, 
Son,  and  Holy  Ghost,  and  the  simple 
oneness  of  God.  The  use  is  admissible,  to 
prevent  circumlocution.  The  word  Trinity 
was  used  by  the  Greek  and  Latin  Fathers, 
in  the  middle  of  the  second  century,  in  a 
way  that  indicated  it  was  not  then  a  novel 
expression,  and  was  considered  by  the  ortho- 
dox so  unobjectionable,  as  to  be  employed 
■without  reserve  in  their  opposition  to  the 
Sabelliau  heresy. 

The  doctrine  of  a  Trinity,  and  this  in: 
Unity,  is  not  then  an  arbitrary  assumption, 
or  an  attempt  to  be  -wise  "  above  that  which 
is  -written ; "  but  it  necessarily  arises  out  of 
many  Scriptural  expressions  and  passages, 
which  though  apparently,  or  to  human  sense, 
contradictory  to  each  other,  must  in  reality 
be  consistent :  and  the  Catholic,  or  othodox 
system,  framed  on  the  whole  of  these,  recon- 
ciles them  in  the  only  possible  way.  Uni- 
tarians are  obliged  to  resort  to  new  transla- 
tions and  incon-ect  versions  of  the  New 
Testament.     [H.] 

TRINITY  SU  ND AY.  The  Sunday  next 
after  Whitsunday.  The  solemn  festivals, 
which  in  the  foregoing  parts  of  our  annual 
service  have  propounded  to  our  consideration 
the  mysterious  work  of  man's  redemption, 
and  the  several  steps  taken  to  accomplish  it, 
and  the  manifestation  of  the  special  work  of 
the  Spirit  on  Whitsunday,  naturally  lead  us 
up  to,  and  at  last  conclude  with,  that  of  the 
Trinity. 

Though  the  Octave  of  Pentecost  Las 
been   observed  in  honour  of  the  Blessed 


752 


TEINE  IMMERSION 


Trinity  from  very  early  times,  the  name 
itself  is  of  comparatively  recent  date.  It 
has  been  used  in  England  since  the  time  of 
St.  Osmund  (a.d.  1080),  and  may  by  him 
have  been  adopted  from  still  earlier  offices  of 
the  Church.  It  appears  to  have  been  re- 
garded as  a  separate  festival  in  the  AVestern 
world  only  by  the  English  Church,  and 
those  Churches  of  Germany  which  owe  their 
origin  to  the  English  Boniface  or  Winfrith. 
Thomas  k  Becket,  who  was  consecrated  on 
the  Octave  of  Whitsunday,  1162,  appointed 
that  Sunday  for  the  Feast  of  Trinity,  and 
the  same  was  appointed  by  a  synod  of  Aries, 
A.D.  1260,  for  that  province ;  but  the  first  to 
enjoin  the  universal  observance  of  the  day 
was  Pope  John  XXII.,  in  1334.  The  reason 
given  why  the  Roman  Church  had  no  sepa- 
rate festival  till  then  is  that  "  it  honoured 
the  Blessed  Trinity  in  its  daily  worship  by 
Doxologies  and  the  Memoria  "  (Patrologus, 
c.  Ix.).  The  Memoria  is  our  Collect  for  this 
day,  and  is  taken  from  the  Gregorian  Sa- 
cramentary. 

The  Epistle  and  the  Gospel  are  the  same 
that  were  anciently  assigned  in  the  Lec- 
tionary  of  St.  Jerome  for  the  Octave  of 
Pentecost,  and  have  always  been  used  in 
the  English  Church ;  the  Epistle  being  the 
vision  of  St.  John  (Rev.  iv.) ;  and  the 
Gospel,  the  dialogue  of  our  Lord  with  Nico- 
demus ;  and  the  mention,  which  we  find 
therein,  of  baptism,  of  the  Holy  Spirit  and 
the  gifts  of  it,  though  it  might  then  fit  the 
■day  as  a  repetition,  as  it  were,  of  Pentecost, 
so  is  it  no  less  fit  for  it  as  a  feast  of  the 
Blessed  Trinity.  In  the  Gospel  we  have  set 
before  us  aU  the  three  Persons  of  the  sacred 
Trinity,  and  the  same  likewise  represented 
in  the  vision,  which  the  Epistle  speaks  of, 
with  an  hymn  of  praise,  "  Holy,  holy,  holy, 
Lord  God  Almighty,"  &c. :  which  expres- 
sions, by  ancient  interpretation,  relate  to  the 
Holy  Trinity,  as  is  above  said. 

In  the  Roman  Church  the  Sundays  be- 
tw  een  Whitsunday  and  Advent  are  reck- 
oned from  Pentecost :  in  our  Church,  fol- 
lowing the  old  English  custom  in  the  un- 
Teformed  office,  we  count  from  Trinity 
Sunday. — Durandus,  Bationale,  de  Frim. 
Bom,,  post  Pent. ;  Martene,  de  Antiq.  Eccl. 
Discip.  xxxviiL  22 ;  Wheatly,  P.  B.  p. 
243  ;  Annot.  P.  B.  i.  114.     [H.] 

TRINE  IMMERSION  (See  Baptism; 
Immersion).  Dipping  or  plunging  the  can- 
didate for  baptism  into  the  water  three 
times.  Tertullian  speaks  thus  of  the  cere- 
mony. "  We  dip  not  once  but  three  times, 
at  the  naming  of  every  Person  of  the 
Trinity  "  (Oorat  Prax.  c.  26  ;  de  Coron.  Mil. 
■c.  3).  In  the  first  of  these  passages  the 
word  for  "  dip "  is  tinguere,  which  may 
mean  simply  wet  or  moisten ;  in  the  second, 
4^he  more  emphatic  word  mergere  is  used. 


TRUCE  OP  GOD 

St.  Ambrose  is  very  full  in  his  description 
of  this  rite  (de  Sacrament,  bk.  ii.  c.  7),  and 
speaks  of  it  as  signifying  Christ's  three  days' 
burial — "  buried  with  them  in  baptism " 
(Col.  ii.  12),  as  do  others  of  the  Fathers, 
as  St.  Basil,  Jerome,  Chrysostom,  &c.  St. 
Augustine  joins  the  two  reasons ;  trine 
immersion  is  both  a  symbol  of  the  Holy 
Trinity,  in  whose  name  we  are  baptized,  and 
also  a  type  of  the  Lord's  burial,  and  of  His 
resurrection  on  the  third  day  from  the  dead 
(Horn.  3  ap.  Cfratian.  de  Consecrat.  Bist.  4, 
cap.  78).  Trine  immersion  was  ordered  in 
the  Prayer  Book  of  1549,  but  omitted  in  that 
of  1552.     [H.] 

TRISAGION  (jpXs,  ayiov,  thrice  holy). 
A  creed  set  hymnwise,  having  special  re- 
ference to  the  work  of  God  for  man  as  set 
forth  in  the  Scriptures,  sung  in  the  Greek 
liturgies  after  the  bringing  in  of  the  Gospel. 
In  the  Roman  rite  it  is  sung  only  once  a 
year — on  Good  Friday. — Freeman's  Princ. 
Biv.  Serv.  ii.  338  (See  Tersanctm). 

TRUCE  OF  GOD.  In  the  French  Treve 
de  Bieu :  in  modern  Latin,  Trevia,  Treuvia, 
Treuga,  or  Truga  Bei. 

In  the  eleventh  century,  when  the  dis- 
orders and  hcences  of  private  wars,  between 
particular  lords  and  families,  were  a  great 
disturbance  to  the  peace  of  the  kingdom 
of  France,  a  remarkable  attempt  was  made 
by  the  clergy  to  bind  men  to  the  observance 
of  peace,  by  abstaining  from  all  acts  of 
violence,  or  revenge.  By  the  Council  of 
Limoges  in  1031,  it  was  decreed  that  if  the 
chiefs  of  the  district  refused  to  comply,  it 
should  be  laid  under  an  interdict.  But  as 
it  was  clearly  impossible  to  enforce  per- 
petual peace,  another  effort  was  made  (about 
1040)  to  mitigate  the  horrors  of  war  by  the 
proposal  of  a  scheme  called  the  Truce  of 
God.  This  scheme  provided  for  the  sus- 
pension of  all  hostilities  from  the  evening  of 
Wednesday  in  each  week  to  the  dawn  of  the 
following  Monday — the  period  sacred  to  the 
memory  of  our  Lord's  betrayal,  crucifixion, 
and  resurrection — also  during  Advent  and 
Lent.  At  a  council  held  at  Elne  (a  city  of 
the  Spanish  March)  in  1047  the  weekly  rest 
from  war  was  reduced  from  four  days  to  two 
— Saturday  and  Sunday.  The  longer  in- 
terval however  was  enacted  by  later  councils ; 
and  received  the  Papal  sanction  from 
Urban  II.  at  the  Council  of  Clermont  in 
A.D.  1094.  The  Truce  of  God  was  renewed 
in  the  strongest  terms  by  Pope  Calixtus  II. 
at  the  Council  of  Reims  in  1119.  There 
were  also  several  regulations  enacted  for  the 
protection  during  war  of  clergy,  monks, 
nuns,  and  women,  for  securing  the  privilege 
of  sanctuary,  and  mitigating  the  injuries 
done  to  the  labours  of  husbandry.  The 
frequent  re-enactments  of  the  Truce  prove 
indeed   that  it  was    irregularly  observed. 


TRUMPETS 

nevertheless  it  must  have  acted  as  a  bene- 
ficial check  upon  the  lawlessness  of  the  age ; 
it  was  a  distinct  recognition  of  the  evUs  of 
war,  and  a  praiseworthy  attempt  to  provide 
some  remedy  for  them. — Sismondi,  iv.  248 ; 
Robertson,  Gli.  Hist.  ii.  544-6 ;  Milman, 
Lat.  Christ,  iii.  152,  207. 

TRUMPETS,  FEAST  OF  (ny-nn  Di*). 

An  annual  festival  of  the  Jews,  expressly 
enjoined  by  the  law  of  Moses,  and  observed 
upon  the  first  day  of  the  seventh  month, 
called  Tisri,  which  was  the  beginning  of  the 
civil  year. 

This  festival  is  expressly  called  a  sabbath, 
and  was  a  very  solemn  day,  on  which  no 
servile  work  was  to  be  done;  only  pro- 
vision made  for  their  meals,  which  were 
usually  very  plentiful  at  this  time  (See 
Smith's  Bid.  Bible,  p.  1572). 

TUNICLE.  An  ecclesiastical  garment 
mentioned  in  the  rubrics  of  King  Edward 
VL's  First  Book,  to  be  worn  by  the  assist- 
ant ministers  at  the  holy  Communion.  It 
is  the  same  as  the  tunic  or  the  dalmatic, 
which  was  also  an  episcopal  garment. 
Originally  it  had  no  sleeves ;  and  was  the 
same  with  the  Greek  colobion.  The  sleeves 
were  added  in  the  West  about  the  fourth 
century ;  and  then  the  vestment  was  called 
a  dalmatic.  The  tunicle  in  the  Roman 
Church  is  proper  to  subdeacons.- — Goar,  Bit. 
Q-rxc.  p.  Ill ;  Palmer's  Orig.  Liturg.  ii. 
314. 

TURRET.  A  small  tower  appended  to  a 
larger  tower,  or  the  angle  or  other  part  of  a 
buUding  for  support,  or  to  carry  stairs,  or  for 
ornament,  or  a  bell.  Like  the  tower,  it  is 
often  finished  with  a  high  conical  capping, 
which  is  then  called  a  spiret  or  pinnacle. 

TYPE  (rxmos,  a  blow,  then  the  mark  of 
a  blow).  An  impression,  image,  or  repre- 
sentation of  some  model,  which  is  termed 
the  antitype.  In  this  sense  we  often  use 
the  word  to  denote  the  prefiguration  of  the 
great  events  of  man's  redemption  by  persons 
or  things  in  the  Old  Testament. 


u. 

UBIQUITARIANS.  A  sect  of  heretics, 
so  called  because  they  maintained  that  the 
body  of  Jesus  Christ  is  (ubigue)  every- 
where, or  in  every  place. 

Brentius,  or  Brentzen,  one  of  the  earliest 
reformers,  is  said  to  have  first  broached  this 
error,  in  Germany,  about  the  year  1560 
(de  Person.  Union.  Brentii,  opp.  viii.  831). 
Melanchthon  immediately  declared  against 
it,  as  introducing  a  kind  of  confusion  in  the 
two  natures  of  Jesus  Christ.  On  the  other 
hand,  it  was  espoused  by  Flacius  lUyricus, 


ULTEAMONTANISTS 


753 


Osiander,  and  others.  The  Universities  of 
Leipsic  and  Wiirtemberg  in  vain  opposed 
this  heresy,  which  gained  ground  daily. 
Six  Ubiquitarians,  viz.  Smidelin,  Selneccer, 
Musculus,  Chemnitius,  Chytrajus  and,  Cor- 
nerus,  had  a  meeting,  in  1577,  in  the  monas- 
tery of  Berg,  and  composed  a  kind  of  creed, 
or  formulary  of  faith,  in  which  the  Ubiquity 
of  Christ's  body  was  the  leading  article. 
However,  the  U  biquitarians  were  not  quite 
agreed  among  themselves ;  some  holding 
that  Jesus  Christ,  even  during  His  mortal 
life,  was  everywhere,  and  others  dating  the 
Ubiquity  of  His  body  from  the  time  of  His 
ascension  only. — Dorner's  Person  of  Ghrist, 
ii.,  ii.  280,  422. 

ULTRAMONTANISTS.  _  Those  who 
claim  for  the  pope  an  unlimited  authority 
in  matters  of  faith  and  discipline  in  every 
part  of  the  Church  of  Christ,  and  assert  his 
infallibility.  Ultramontanism  dates  from 
Gregory  VII.  (Hildebrand,  a.d.  1073),  who 
asserted, "  Quod  solus  Papa  possit  uti  imperi- 
alibus  insigniis ; — quod  solius  Papas  pedes 
omnes  principes  deosculentur; — quod  illi 
liceat  Impera tores  deponere; — quod  a  fideli- 
tate  iniquorum  subjectos  possit  absolvere." 
But  the  infallibility  of  the  pope  was  not 
introduced  into  the  schools  till  the  fifteenth 
century  (Fleury,  lib.  xoiii.  c.  15). 

Cardinal  Bellannine  (a.d.  1599)  was  the 
great  upholder  and  writer  of  the  Ultra- 
montane doctrines,  and  he  lays  down  that 
the  pope,  when  teaching  the  whole  Church 
in  matters  of  faith,  cannot  err ;  whence  it 
follows  that  the  Church  of  Rome  cannot 
err;  nor  can  the  pope  err  in  precepts  of 
morals  which  are  prescribed  to  the  whole 
Church,  and  which  relate  to  things  necessary 
to  salvation,  or  to  such  as  are  good  or  bad. 
in  themselves  (Disp.  de  Summo  Pont.  iv. 
2-5). 

The  question  of  the  precise  relation  be- 
tween the  authority  of  the  pope  and  that  of 
the  general  councils  was  keenly  argued  for 
more  than  250  years,  the  Ultramontane 
party  elevating  the  pope  to  a  position  of 
feudal  supremacy,  and  maintaining  that 
his  decrees  are  in  themselves  sufficient, 
whether  or  not  accepted  by  the  body  of 
bishops;  the  moderates,  or  Galilean  party, 
holding  that  the  pope  is,  with  regard  to  the 
body  of  bishops,  only  primus  inter  pares, 
and  that  his  decrees  are  the  expression  of 
their  opinions.  It  remained  for  Pope  Pius 
IX.  to  make  this  an  article  of  faith  in  the 
Roman  Church.  In  1854  he  proclaimed 
on  his  own  authority  the  dogma  of  the 
Immaculate  Conception ;  for  although  there 
were  fifty-three  cardinals,  forty-three  arch- 
bishops, and  a  hundred  bishops  at  the 
assembly,  there  was  no  synodal  authority, 
for  they  had  been  selected  and  invited  for 
their  well-known  opinions.     In  1870  the 


•754 


UNCTION 


pope  went  a  step  further,  and  promulgated 
the  dogma  of  Papal  Infallibility.  This 
naturally  has  caused  much  division  and 
discussion,  to  ■which  reference  is  made  in  the 
.  article  on  Old  Catholics.     [H.] 

UNCTION  (See  Extreme  Unction). 

UNIFOBMITY,  ACTS  OF.  By  Acts  1 
Edw.  VI.  c.  1,  and  5  &  6  Edw.  VI.,  it  was 
ordered  that  whereas  there  had  been  diver- 
sity in  the  services  of  the  Church,  as  in  the 
uses  of  Sarum,  of  York,  of  Bangor,  and  of 
Lincoln,  and  divers  other  uses,  there  should 
be  "  one  convenient  and  meet  order  of  com- 
mon and  open  prayer."  And  this  was  to  be 
observed  by  all  ministers.  1  Mary,  c.  2,  re- 
versed this,  and  ordered  that  "all  such  Divine 
service,  and  administration  of  sacraments, 
as  were  most  commonly  used  in  England 
in  the  last  year  of  Henry  VIIL,  shall  be 
used  throughout  the  realm."  1  Eliz.  c.  2, 
restored  the  order  of  5  &  6  Edw.  VI.  "  with 
the  alteration  or  addition  of  certain  lessons 
to  be  used  on  every  Sunday  in  the  year, 
and  the  form  of  Litany  altered  and  corrected, 
and  two  sentences  only  added  in  the  delivery 
of  the  sacrament  to  the  communicants,  and 
none  other  or  otherwise."  13  &  14  Car. 
II.  c.  4,  is  that  which  is  known  as  the  "  Act 
of  Uniformity."  It  recites  that  "in  the 
first  year  of  the  late  Queen  Elizabeth  there 
was  one  uniform  order  of  common  service 
and  prayer,  and  of  the  administration  of 
sacraments,  rites,  and  ceremonies  in  the 
Church  of  England,"  yet  that  "  a  great 
number  of  people  wilfully  and  sohismatically 
abstain  and  refuse  to  come  to  their  parish 
churches,"  and  that  "by  the  great  and 
scandalous  neglect  of  ministers,  great  mis- 
chiefs and  inconvenienoies  during  the  times 
of  the  late  unhappy  troubles  have  arisen 
.and  grown,  and  many  people  have  been  led 
into  factions  and  schisms,"  therefore  "His 
Majesty  hath  been  pleased  to  authorize  and 
require  the  Presidents  of  the  Convocations 
of  Canterbury  and  York  and  other  the  bishops 
and  clergy  of  the  same,  to  review  the  Book 
of  Common  Prayer,  and  the  book  of  the 
form  and  manner  of  the  making  and  con- 
secrating  of  bishops,   priests  and  deacons 

.  .  .  and  they  have  exhibited  and  pre- 
sented the  same  nnto  His  Majesty  in  one 
book,  intituled  "The  Boole  of  Common 
Prayer,  and  Administration  of  the  Sacra- 
ments, and  other  Rites  and  Ceremonies  of 
the  Church,  according  to  the  Use  of  the  Church 
of  England,  together  with  the  Psalter,  or 
Psalms  of  David,  pointed  as  they  are  to  he 
said  or  sung  in  Churclies  ;  and  the  form  and 
manner  of  making,  ordaining  and  conse- 
crating of  bishops,  priests  and  deacons." 
By  the  second  section  of  the  Act  it  was 
ordered  that,  whereas  nothing  conduces  more 
to  the  settling  of  the  peace  of  this  nation, 
nor  to  the  honour  of  oui-  religion,  than  a 


UNIFOEMITY 

universal  agreement  in  the  public  worship 
of  Almighty  God,  all  and  singular  ministers 
in  any  cathedral,  collegiate  or  parish  church 
or  chapel,  shall  be  bound  to  say  and  use  the  ; 
Morning  Prayer,  Evening  Prayer,  celebration  ' 
and  administration  of  both  the  sacraments, 
and  all  other  the  jiublic  and  common  prayer 
in  such  order  and  form  as  is  mentioned  in 
the  said  book,  annexed  and  joined  to  this 
present  Act,  and  intituled  "The  Book  o(] 
Common  Prayer,"  &c.  The  Act  of  Uui- ! 
formity  passed  both  Houses  of  Parliament  on 
July  9,  1662  (See  also  the  Preface  to  the  : 
Prayer  Book).  In  1872  an  Act  "  for  the  \ 
Amendment  of  the  Act  of  Uniformity" 
was  passed.  It  sanctions,  (1)  The  use  of  a 
short^ened  form  of  Morning  and  Evening 
Prayer  therein  prescribed,  on  any  day  except 
Sunday,  Christmas  Day,  Ash-Wednesday, 
Good  Friday,  and  Ascension  Day,  in  lieu 
of  the  Usual  Order  for  Morning  and  Evening 
Prayer ;  but  if  in  a  cathedral,  "in  addition 
to,"  not  "  in  lieu  of,"  the  ordinary  services. 
(2)  Any  special  form  of  service,  approved  by 
the  ordinary  for  any  special  occasion,  such 
service,  with  the  exception  of  hymns  and 
anthems,  to  be  taken  exclusively  from  the 
Bible  or  Prayer  Book  (See  Hymns).  (3) 
The  use  of  additional  sei-vices  on  Sundays 
and  Holydays,  such  services,  with  the 
exception  of  the  hymns  and  anthems,  to 
be  taken  from  the  Bible  or  Prayer  Book, 
and  approved  by  the  ordinary.  (4)  The 
separation  of  the  Order  of  Morning  Prayer, 
the  Litany,  and  the  Communion  Service; 
and  the  use  of  the  Litany  after  the  third 
collect  at  Evening  Prayer  either  in  lieu  of, 
or  in  addition  to,  the  use  of  it  in  the  morning. 
(5)  The  preaching  a  sermon,  without  a  i)re- 
vious  service.  The  Act  for  the  AboUtiou 
of  University  Tests,  passed  in  1871,  had 
already  repealed  some  of  the  sections  of 
Charles's  Act,  in  so  far  as  they  excluded 
Nonconformists  from  the  Universities  of 
Oxford  and  Cambridge. 

Eomaiusts  and  Protestant  Dissenters  con- 
tinually talk  of  the  ejectment  of  their  re- 
spective predecessors  under  the  two  Acts  of 
Uniformity  of  Elizabeth  and  Charles  II., 
carefully  suppressing  their  own  treatment  of 
the  Anglican  clergy  when  they  had  the 
opportunity.  The  number  of  ejectments  of 
the  existing  clergy  under  Mary  is  unknown, 
and  not  worth  inquiry  into  by  the  side  of 
the  infinitely  worse  persecution  of  Protes- 
tants throughout  her  reign.  It  is  well 
known,  and  has  not  been  controverted,  that 
the  deprivations  of  Marian  clergy  who 
refused  to  resume  the  Protestant  Prayer 
Book  under  the  Act  of  1559  were  only  189. 
The  Dissenters,  on  the  authority  of  Calamy, 
have  always  talked  of  their  "  2000  martyrs 
who  were  ejected  on  Bartholomew's  day  in 
1662,"  for  refusing  to  conform  to  the  Prayer 


UNIGEMITUS 

Book,  -wliicli  was  practically  tlie  old  one, 
^nd  at  any  rate  no  more  anti-Presbyterian. 
They  cai-efuUy  forget  that  those  were  only 
a  small  portion  of  the  Puritan  intruders  and 
ejectors  of  sixteen  years  before.  Dr.  Little- 
dale  (in  the  Times  of  5th  Oct.,  1886)  said 
that  it  is  quite  certain  that  Calamy's  figure 
of  293  recusants  in  the  diocese  of  London 
ought  to  be  127,  for  which  he  refers  to 
authorities ;  and  so,  if  the  same  proportion 
of  exaggeration  prevailed  generally  the  as- 
serted "  2000  martyrs  "  ought  to  be  "  867 
intruders,"  or  about  a  seventh  of  the  Angli- 
■can  incumbents  ejected  by  the  Puritans  a 
few  years  before,  who  are  known  to  have 
been  between  5000  and  6000.     [G.] 

TJNIGENITUS,  THE  BULL.  The  in- 
strument, of  which  Unigenitus  was  the 
first  word,  issued  by  Pope  Clement  XI.,  in 
1713,  against  the  French  translation  of  the 
New  Testament,  with  notes,  by  Pasquier 
Quesnel,  priest  of  the  Oratory,  and  a  cele- 
Ijrated  jansenist.  The  book,  having  occa- 
sioned considerable  disputes,  had  already 
been  condemned  by  the  Court  of  Home  in 
1708 ;  but  this  step  being  found  ineftectual, 
•Clement,  who  had  privately  spoken  of  it 
in  terms  of  rapture,  declaring  it  to  be  an 
•excellent  book,  and  one  which  no  person 
resident  at  Pome  was  capable  of  writing, 
proceeded  to  condemn  one  hundred  and 
one  propositions  of  the  notes;  such  as — 
^race,  the  effectual  principle  of  all  good 
works ;  faith,  the  fhst  and  fountain  of  all 
the  graces  of  a  Christian;  the  Scriptures 
should  be  read  by  all,  &c.  U'his  bull,  pro- 
■cured  by  Louis  and  the  Jesuits,  occasioned 
•great  commotion  in  France.  Forty  Gallican 
tiishops  accepted  it ;  but  it  was  opposed  by 
many  others,  especially  by  Noailles,  arch- 
bishop of  Paris.  Many  of  the  prelates,  and 
-other  persons  eminent  for  piety  and  leai-ning, 
-appealed,  on  the  subject,  fi-om  the  papal 
^.uthority  to  that  of  a  general  council,  but 
in  vain. 

UNION,  HYPOSTATICAL  (fvcoo-is-  Ka6' 
imooTaa-iv).  A  term  of  dogmatic  theology 
first  used  by  Cyril  of  Alexandria  in  his 
second  epistle  to  Nestorius,  a.d.  430.  It 
implies  the  union  of  the  human  nature  of 
Christ  with  the  Divine,  constituting  two 
natm-es  in  one  person.  Not  consuhstantially, 
as  the  three  persons  in  the  Godhead ;  nor 
jphysiccdly,  as  soul  and  body  united  in  one 
person;  nor  mystically,  as  is  the  union 
'between  Christ  and  believers ;  but  so  as 
that  the  manhood  subsist  in  the  second 
person,  yet  without  making  confusion,  both 
making  but  one  person.  It  was  miracvlous 
•(Luke  i.  34,  35).  Complete  and  real ;  Christ 
took  a  real  human  body  and  soul,  and  not 
in  appearance.     Inseparable  (Heb.  vii.  25). 

"  As  oft  as  we  attribute  to  God  what  the 
.manhood  of  Christ  claims,  or  to  man  what 


UNITARIANS  .  755 

his  Deity  hath  right  unto,  we  understand 
by  the  Name  of  God,  and  the  name  of  Man, 
neither  the  one  nor  the  other  nature,  but 
the  whole  Person  of  Christ  in  Whom  both 
natures  are." — Hooker's  Ecc.  Pol.  v.,  li.-lv. 

UNITARIANS.  A  title  which  certain 
heretics,  who  do  not  worship  God,  as  re- 
vealed in  the  Bible,  assume  most  unfairly,  as 
if  those  who  do  so  worship  Him  do  not  hold 
the  doctrine  of  the  Divine  Uruty.  Chris- 
tians worship  the  Trinity  in  Unity,  and  the 
Unity  in  Trinity. 

This  name  includes  all,  whether  Arians 
of  old,  or  more  lately  Socinians,  and  other 
Deists,  who  deny  the  Divinity  of  Jesus 
Christ,,  and  the  separate  jjersonality  of  the 
Holy  Ghost.  They  are  not  very  numerous 
in  England,  although  most  of  the  old 
English  Presbyterian  congregations  have 
fallen  into  Unitarianism. 

The  sect  made  Mttle  progress  in  England 
till  the  opening  of  the  eighteenth  century, 
when  many  of  the  old  Presbyterian  ministers 
embraced  opinions  adverse  to  the  Trinitarian 
doctrme.  In  1708,  Whiston  published  his 
essay  upon  the  Apostolic  Constitutions,  to 
prove  that  the  Arian  was  the  doctrine  of  the 
primitive  Church ;  and  he  was  followed  by 
an  abler  man,  Samuel  Clarke,  who  in  1712 
published  his  Scripture  Doctrine  of  the 
Trinity.  A  controversy  thereupon  took 
place,  very  voluminous,  which  increased  in 
warmth  when  the  bishop  of  London,  in  1718, 
peremptorily  forbade  the  Arian  alteration  of 
the  Doxology,  which  had  been  introduced 
at  St.  James's,  Westminster.  Amongst  the 
Dissenters  too  there  was  no  less  voluminous 
controversy  on  the  subject,  especially  in  the 
West  of  England,  and  two  Presbyterian 
ministers.  Pierce  and  HaUett  of  Exeter,  in 
consequence  of  theu-  participation  in  these 
sentiments,  were  removed  from  their  pastoral 
charges.  Nevertheless,  the  Presbyterian 
clergy  gradually  became  infected  with  the 
heresy,  although  for  some  time  they  gave  no 
particular  expression  from  their  pulpits  to 
their  views  in  this  respect.  In  course  of 
little  time,  however,  their  congregations 
either  came  to  be  entirely  assimilated  with 
themselves  in  doctrine,  or  in  part  seceded  to 
the  Independent  body. 

Many  of  the  clergy  who  held  Unitarian 
views  managed  to  keep  their  livings,  such 
as  Blackburne,  who  was  certainly  an  Anti- 
trinitarian  (Confessional  (1772),  p.  359). 
"  In  fact,  a  singular  want  of  opermess  and 
proper  Christian  candour  seemed  to  have 
been  a  general  characteristic  of  the  party." 
Clarke's  recantation  was  no  proper  recanta- 
tion ;  several  of  the  clergy  satisfied  their  con- 
sciences by  altering  the  litm-gy  (Whiston's 
Memoirs,  2nd  ed.  p.  213  ;  Pairbairn's  App. 
to  Dorner,  p.  401).  Some  were  more 
honest,  gave  up  their    livings,   and  cele- 

3   c  2 


756 


UNITED  BRETHREN 


brated  Unitarian  worship  after  Dr.  Clarke's 
refonned  liturgy  in  their  own  houses.  These 
Avere  gathered  together  by  the  exertions  and 
influence  of  Dr.  Priestley,  who  was  helped 
by  Belsham,  a  man  of  superior  ability,  whose 
work,  Cairn  Inquiry  (1811),  is  the  ablest  of 
modern  Unitarianism,  and  may  be  taken  as 
a  standard  of  Unitarian  doctrine.  His 
improved  version  of  the  New  Testament, 
however,  is  full  of  mistakes  and  falsifi- 
cations. 

Persons  denying  the  doctrine  of  the  Trinity 
were  excepted  from  the  benefits  of  the  Tolera- 
tion Act,  and  remained  so  until  1813,  when 
the  section  in  that  statute  which  afiected 
them  was  abrogated  by  the  53  Geo.  III.  c. 
160,  which  was  extended  to  Ireland  by  .57 
Greo.  III.  c.  70.  Since  that  period  they 
have  been  exactly  in  the  same  position  as 
all  other  Protestant  Dissenters  with  respect 
to  their  political  immunities.  These  persons 
do  not  object  to  the  form  of  attestation  "  on 
the  true  faith  of  a  Christian,"  though  deny- 
ing the  principal  doctrines  of  Christianity 
as  recognised  by  the  Catholic  Church. 

The  form  of  ecclesiastical  government 
adopted  by  the  Unitarians  is  substantially 
"  congregational ; "  each  individual  congre- 
gation ruling  itself  without  regard  to  any 
courts  or  synods.  The  Unitarian  Calendar 
gives  about  380  congregations  of  Unitarians 
with  mission  stations,  334  societies  in 
America,  116  in  Transylvania,  with  50,000 
members.  —  Domer,  On  the  Person  of 
Christ,  with  Appendix  by  Dr.  Fairbairn ; 
Whiston's  Memoirs,  1st  ed.  p.  121 ;  Blunt's 
Diet.  Sects,  606. 

UNITED  BRETHREN  (See  Moravians). 
UNIVERSALISTS.  Those  who  beheve 
in  the  ultimate  salvation  of  all  mankind, 
whether  wicked  or  good.  This  is  no  new 
idea,  as  it  was  held  by  Origen  and  his  fol- 
lowers, and  doubtless  by  many  others  in 
their  private  opinion,  especially  those  who 
maintain  Unitarianism.  It  is  a  comfortable 
doctrine  for  sinners.  As-  a  distinct  sect, 
Universalists  have  not  made  any  great 
impression.  One  ReiUy,  an  Unitarian 
preacher,  got  together  a  congregation  on 
this  basis  in  London,  and  he  was  followed 
by  Winchester,  an  American  preacher,  a.d. 
1781,  but  the  congregation  failed,  and  was 
soon  broken  up.  In  America,  on  the  con- 
trary, a  large  sect  of  Universalists  was 
formed  (quite  distinct  from  the  Unitarians), 
which  flourished,  especially  at  Boston,  under 
the  name  of  the  Independent  Christian  Uni- 
versalists, and  still  flourishes.  In  the  first 
place  this  was  a  reaction  against  the  terrible 
doctrines  of  Calvinism,  but  latterly  it  has 
assumed  a  different  aspect,  and  the  denial  of 
the  eternity  of  future  punishment  tends  to 
weaken  the  sense  of  moral  responsibility, 
leading  through  Antinomianism  to  Deism. 


XJNIVEESITY 

As  an  opinion,  Universalism  is  very  common' 
among  English  laymen,  and  has  been  main- 
tained by  some  English  clergy,  the  most 
influential  of  whom  have  been  in  recent 
times  Professor  Maurice  and  Canon  Parrar, 
though  the  latter  strenuously  denies  that  he 
is  a  Universalist.  But  it  is  hard  to  see  the 
distinction.  —  Whitemore's  Hii^t.  of  Uni- 
versalism, Boston,  1860 ;  Farrar's  Sermons ; 
Maurice,  Theol.  Essays,  Moral  and  Meta- 
physical Philosophy  ;  Blunt's  Diet.  Tlieol.  ; 
Blunt's  Diet.  Sects.     [H.] 

UNIVERSITY.  University,  as  Johnson 
observes,  originally  meant  a  community  or 
corporation ; — it  afterwards  came  to  be  re- 
stricted to  those  communities  for  divine  and 
secular  learning,  which  were  originally 
called  studia  generalia,  schools,  pedagogies 
(as  St.  Andrew's),  academies,  &c.  In  all  of 
these,  the  four  great  branches  of  knowledge 
were  professed,  divinity,  law,  medicine,  and 
the  liberal  arts  and  sciences.  In  the  twelfth 
century,  degrees  were  conferred  (see  Degrees), 
first  in  canon  and  civil  law,  afterwards  in 
theology  and  philosophy ;  though  all  these 
branches  of  learning  had  long  been  taught. 
The  universities  were  gradually  endowed 
with  important  privileges.  For  ages  they 
had  been  regarded  in  England  as  great  and 
influential,  with  corporate  titles,  though  not 
with  corporate  privileges.  These  were  for- 
mally given  to  them  by  Queen  Elizabeth, 
under  whose  auspices  the  third  University 
of  Dublin,  endowed  with  like  privileges,  was 
founded. 

It  is  foreign  to  the  object  of  a  Chui'ch 
Dictionai'y  to  notice  those  corporations  for 
mere  secular  learning,  to  which  in  England 
the  title  of  University,  though  with  a  novel 
meaning,  has  of  late  years  been  legally  given. 
The  term,  as  formerly  understood  in  Eng- 
land, Ireland,  and  Scotland,  as  throughout 
Europe  for  ages,  comprehended  Divine 
learning  as  an  essential  and  crowning  part 
of  the  system.  The  old  universities  are 
connected  with  the  Church  by  the  closest 
ties.  Their  discipline  is  recognised  by  the 
canons  (the  xvi.,  xxii.,  and  xviii.,  for  ex- 
ample), and  their  degrees  are  essential 
qualifications  for  many  Church  preferments ; 
these  also  were  conferred  under  the  invo- 
cation of  the  Holy  Trinity ;  all  their  solemn 
assemblies  were  accompanied  with  the 
prayers  of  the  Church ;  and  the  foundations 
within  the  universities,  upon  which  their 
influence  and  very  existence  depend,  have 
been  made  with  the  plain  and  obvious  under- 
standing that  these  great  corporations  are 
the  nurseries  of  the  Church ;  that  those  who 
partake  of  their  privileges  are  to  be  educated 
as  her  generic  children.  But  this  has  all 
been  changed  in  late  years,  and  the  original 
intention  of  the  founders  of  colleges  in  the 
great  universities  has    been    ignored,   and 


UEIM  AND  THUMMDI 

Dissenters  and  Atheists  admitted  to  advan- 
tages and  emoluments  and  power,  wliich 
had  all  been  provided  for  the  Church  of 
England. 

URIM  AND  THUMMIM  (D'^W, 
CiSPI :  SfjXa(ns  KoL  aXr]6fia :  doctrina  et 
Veritas).  So  the  Hebrews  called  a  certain 
■oracular  manner  of  consulting  God ;  which 
was  done  by  the  high  priest,  dressed  in  his 
robes,  and  having  on  his  pectoral,  or  breast- 
plate. Inside  the  breastplate  were  placed 
■"  the  Urim  and  Thummim  " ;  and  they  were 
to  be  on  Aaron's  heart,  when  he  went  in 
before  the  Lord  (Ex.  xxviii.  15-30).  There 
is  no  description  of  the  TJrim  and  Thummim, 
■and  for  the  many  theories  regarding  them 
reference  must  be  made  to  Dean  Plumptre's 
article  in  the  Diet,  of  the  Bible. 

It  is  a  matter  of  conjecture  when  this 
Urim  and  Thummim  entirely  ceased :  there 
is,  however,  no  instance  of  it  in  Scripture 
■during  the  first  temple ;  nor  in  the  second. 
And  hence  came  that  saying  among  the 
Jews,  that  the  Holy  Spirit  spake  to  the 
Israelites  during  the  tabernacle,  by  Urim 
and  Thummim ;  under  the  first  temple,  by 
the  prophets;  and,  under  the  second,  by 
Bath-Col. 

UESULINES.  An  order  of  nuns,  found- 
■ed  originally  by  St.  Angeli,  of  Brescia,  in 
the  year  1537,  and  so  called  from  St.  Ursula, 
to  whom  they  are  dedicated. 

USE.  In  former  times  each  bishoji  had 
the  power  of  making  improvements  in 
the  liturgy  of  his  church:  in  process  of 
time,  diflerent  customs  arose,  and  several 
became  so  established  as  to  receive  the 
names  of  their  respective  churches.  Thus 
gradually  the  "  Uses  "  or  customs  of  York, 
Sarum,  Hereford,  Bangor,  Lincoln,  Aberdeen, 
&c.,  some  of  which  are  referred  to  in  the 
original  preface  to  the  Prayer  Book,  came  to 
be  distinguished  from  each  other,  thus 
showing  the  independence  of  the  English 
Church,  which  never  accepted  the  Roman 
Kitual.  MS.  copies  of  early  English  "  Uses  " 
are  found  in  most  of  our  great  libraries,  and 
the  missals  and  other  ritual  books  of  Sarum, 
York,  and  Hereford  have  been  printed. 
Independently  of  these  "  Uses  "  of  particular 
■dioceses,  the  monastic  societies  of  England 
had  many  difierent  rituals,  which,  however, 
all  agreed  substantially,  having  all  been 
derived  from  the  Sacramentary  of  Gregory, 
which  dates  long  before  the  assumption  of 
universal  authority  by  the  Bishop  of  Rome. 
The  Benedictine,  Carthusian,  Cistercian,  and 
other  orders,  had  peculiar  missals.  Schul- 
tingius  nearly  transcribes  a  very  ancient 
sacramentary  belonging  to  the  Benedictines 
of  England ;  Bishop  Barlow,  in  his  MS. 
notes  on  the  Roman  missal,  speaks  of  a 
missal  belonging  to  the  monastery  of  Eve- 
sham ;  and  Zaccaria  mentions  a  MS.  missal 


USE 


757 


of  Oxford,  written  in  the  thirteenth  or  four- 
teenth centmy,  which  is  in  the  library  of 
the  canons  of  S.  Salvator  at  Bologna.  This 
last  must  probably  be  referred  to  some  of 
tbe  monastic  societies,  who  had  formerly 
houses  in  Oxford  ;  as  the  bishopric  or 
church  of  Oxford  was  not  founded  till  the 
sixteenth  century. 

But  the  most  important  "  Use,"  both 
because  of  its  universality,  and  as  from  it 
our  Prayer  Book  was  chiefly  formed,  was 
that  of  Sarum.  This  was  arranged  by 
Osmund,  bishop  of  Salisbury  about  a.d. 
1083.  A  great  distm-bance  and  riot  had 
been  caused  by  the  overbearing  action  of 
Nonnan  Thurstan,  who  had  been  appointed 
abbot  of  Glastonbmy  by  William  I.  {fihron. 
Sax.  ad  ann.  1083).  Thurstan  was  evidently 
in  theivrong,  and  was  removed  from  his  post 
by  the  king,  though  afterwards  reinstated 
by  WiUiam  Rufus  on  payment  of  a  fine 
(Mahnesbury,  Eist.  Olaston.  col.  1731,  ed. 
Migne).  He  was  a  man,  according  to  Roger 
of  Hoveden,  "not  worthy  to  be  named." 
He  starved  his  community  for  his  own  gain, 
kept  them  out  of  their  library,  sold  their 
books  {Chroii.  Sax.  ad  ann.  1083),  and 
endeavom-ed  to  change  their  old  use  of 
chanting  to  a  more  modern  style  introduced 
by  William  of  Fecamp.  To  prevent  any 
such  scandal,  and  an  arbitrary  change  of 
ritual  in  his  diocese,  Osmund  put  forth  the 
"  Use  of  Salisbury."  He  was  a  man  of  note. 
He  had  fought  for  the  Conqueror,  and  had 
been  promoted  to  high  honour.  He  was  the 
second  chancellor  whom  William  appointed 
after  his  accession  to  the  throne.  He  be- 
came bishop  of  Salisbury  in  1078,  when  he 
apphed  his  powerful  mind  to  ecclesiastical 
affairs.  Having  settled  his  see  at  old  Sarum, 
he  completed  the  cathedral  which  his  pre- 
decessor had  begun ;  he  collected  together 
clergy  distinguished  for  their  learning  and 
skill  in  chanting ;  and  with  their  assistance 
he  ascertained  all  rubrics,  which  were  not 
sufiiciently  determinate,  or  where  books, 
through  the  inaccuracy  of  transcribers,  were 
inconsistent  with  each  other;  he  adjusted 
and  settled  the  ceremonial  on  points  which 
had  been  previously  left  to  the  discretion  of 
the  officiating  minister ;  in  fine,  he  produced 
a  "  custom  book,"  or  use,  which  was  wholly 
or  partially  adopted  in  various  parts  of  the 
kingdom,  especially  in  the  South  of  England. 
The  first  edition  of  the  Salisbury  Breviary 
was  printed  at  Venice  in  1483.  With 
several  interpolations  introduced  from  time 
to  time,  it  became  the  model  ritual  of  the 
Church  of  England,  until  the  reign  of  Plfilip 
and  Mary,  when  many  of  the  clergy  re- 
ceived licenses  from  Cardinal  Pole  to  say 
the  Roman  breviary.  In  the  reign  of 
Edward  VI.,  and  in  that  of  Queen  EUzahetli, 
the   Sarum  Use  became  the   basis   of  our 


758' 


VACANCY 


present  Book  of  Common  Prayer.  As  tho  rites 
of  the  churches  throughout  the  British 
empire  were  not  by  any  means  uniform  at 
the  middle  of  the  sixteenth  century,  the 
metropohtan  of  Canterbury,  and  other 
bishops  and  doctors  of  tlie  holy  Catholic 
Church,  at  the  request  and  desire  of  King 
Edward  VI.,  revised  the  ritual  books ;  and 
having  examined  the  Oriental  liturgies,  and 
the  notices  which  the  orthodox  Fathers 
supply,  they  edited  the  English  Eitual, 
containing  the  common  prayer  and  adminis- 
tration of  all  the  sacraments  and  rites  of  the 
Church.  And  although  our  liturgy  and 
other  offices  were  corrected  and  improved, 
chiefly  after  the  example  of  the  ancient 
Gallican,  Spanish,  Alexandrian,  and  Ori- 
ental, yet  the  greater  portion  of  our  prayers 
have  been  continually  retained  and  used  by 
the  Church  of  England  for  more  than  1200 
years,  as  may  be  seen  from  comparison  of 
the  Prayer  Book  with  the  Use  of  Sarum. — 
Palmer's  Orig.  Lit.  i.  186;  Maskell,  Mon. 
Bit.  Ang.  Ecd.  i.  xcvi. :  iii.  1 ;  Hook's 
ArcJibisJwps,  ii.  164.     [H.] 


V. 

VACANCY  of  any  ecclesiastical  ofSce  or 
preferment  may  be  effected  by  resignation 
and  its  acceptance  by  the  proper  superior, 
or  by  appointment  to  something  else  which 
vacates  it  by  law,  either  at  once  or  after 
some  time  fixed  by  statute,  as  a  deanery 
vacates  a  living  in  six  months  unless  it 
is  within  the  allowed  value  and  distance 
(see  Dean),  while  institution  to  any  prefer- 
ment inconsistent  with  the  Plurality  Acts 
vacates  the  previous  one  at  once  (See  Plu- 
rality). Election  and  confirmation,  or 
appointment  by  letters  patent,  to  a  bishopric 
(not  colonial  or  sufiragan)  vacates  all  other 
preferment,  and  no  licence  to  hold  it  in 
commendam  can  now  be  given.  Appoint- 
ment to  an  English  bishopric  (not  suffragan) 
also  gives  the  Crown  the  presentation  to 
all  preferment  then  held  by  the  bishop.  If 
the  patronage  belongs  to  A-,  B.,  and  0.  in 
turn,  and  it  is  A.'s  turn  to  present,  he  does 
not  lose  it,  but  has  the  next,  and  so  they 
are  all  postponed;  or  you  may  say  that 
the  Crown  presentation  does  not  count,  but 
is  a  mere  substitution  of  one  incumbent  for 
another,  without  regard  to  any  patron.  The 
Crown  has  all  the  profits  of  a  vacant  see, 
and  all  its  rights  of  patronage,  not  only 
uutil  the  new  bishop  is  appointed  or  con- 
firmed, but  until  he  has  "  done  homage  "  to 
the  Queen.  The  guardian  of  the  spiritu- 
alities, who  is  generally  the  metropolitan, 
but  in  some  cases  the  dean  and  chapter  by 


VALENTINIANS 

special  grant,  performs  all  ecclesiastical  func- 
tions during  the  vacancy,  with  the  aid  of  a 
bishop  for  such  as  require  one,  which  is 
hard  upon  the  doers  of  the  work.  In  some 
cases  the  archbishop  of  a  province  has  had 
to  do  all  the  work  of  another  diocese  for  a 
long  time,  gratis. 

The  profits  of  all  other  preferments  and 
benefices  go  to  the  successor  by  28  Hen.  VIII. 
c.  11.  During  the  vacancy  of  a  deanery 
the  chapter  cannot  do  official  acts  which 
require  to  be  done  in  the  name  of  the  dean 
and  chapter,  though  the  dean's  presence  or 
concurrence  is  not  necessary.  During  the 
vacancy  of  a  living  the  churchwardens  have 
to  take  out  a  sequestration  to  receive  and 
take  care  of  the  profits,  and  pay  so  much  as, 
is  assigned  by  the  bishop  to  the  curate  whom 
he  appoints  to  serve,  by  that  same  Act  and 

1  &  2  Vict.  c.  106,  s.  100,  and  if  the  profits- 
then  are  not  sufficient,  they  are  to  be  de- 
ducted from  the  successor.  They  have  alsa 
to  take  care  of  the  parsonage  and  all  other 
property  of  the  living,  but  subject  to  the 
widow's  right  to  keep  the  house  for  two 
months  after  the  incumbent's  death.     By 

2  &  3  Vict.  c.  49,  s.  6,  new  parishes  may  be 
formed  during  vacancy  of  the  benefice  or 
benefices  affected,  with  the  consent  of  the 
patrons.     [Gr.] 

VALENTINIANS.  Followers  of  the- 
Gnostic  heresy,  who  sprang  up  in  the  second, 
century,  and  were  so  called  from  their  leader, 
Valentinus.  This  sect  was  very  numerous, 
a  fact  which  TertuUian  ascribes  to  the  air  of 
mystery  with  which  their  doctrines  were  sur- 
rounded (.4di;.  Valent.  i.).  Valentinus  (circ. 
A.D.  132-161)  was  an  Egyptian,  but  if  we 
may  judge  from  his  Hellenistic  expressions, 
and  the  Aramaic  names  which  appear  in  his 
system,  he  was  of  Jewish  origin.  His- 
success  as  a  teacher  made  him  aspire  to  the 
episcopacy;  but  another  having  been  pre- 
ferred before  him,  Valentinus,  enraged  at 
this  denial,  and  resolved  to  revenge  himself 
of  the  supposed  affront  given  him,  departed, 
from  the  doctrine  of  the  Church,  and 
assmned  the  title  of  a  Gnostic.  He  began 
to  preach  his  doctrine  in  Egypt,  and  from, 
thence,  coming  to  Rome,  under  the  pontifi- 
cate of  Pope  Hyginus,  he  there  spread  his 
errors,  and  continued  to  dogmatise  till  the 
pontificate  of  Anicetus,  i.e.  from  the  year 
140  to  160.— Euseb.  E.  E.  iv.  2. 

Of  all  the  Gnostics,  none  formed  a  more 
regular  system  than  Valentinus.  His  notions 
were  drawn  from  the  principles  of  the  Pla- 
tonists.  The  jEons  were  attributes  of  the 
Deity,  or  Platonic  ideas,  which  he  realized, 
or  made  persons  of  them,  to  compose  thereof 
a  complete  deity,  which  he  called  Pleroma, 
or  Plenitude ;  under  which  was  the  Creator 
of  the  world,  and  the  angels,  to  whom  he 
committed  the  government  of  it.     The  most 


VALENTINE,  ST. 

ancient  heretics  had  already  established  those 
principles,  and  invented  genealogies  of  the 
jEons  (see  Gnostics) ;  but  Valentinus, 
refining  upon  what  they  had  said,  placed 
them  in  a  new  order,  and  thereto  added 
many  fictions.     His  system  was  this  : 

In  the  Pleroma  he  supposed  thirty  ^ons, 
fifteen  males  and  fifteen  females.  Besides 
these,  there  were  four  unmarried;  Horus 
(opor),  Christ,  the  Holy  Spirit,  and  Jesus. 
The  youngest  of  the  Mons,  Sophia  (Wis- 
dom), fired  with  vast  desire  of  comprehend- 
ing the  nature  of  the  Supreme  Deity,  in  her 
agitation  brought  forth  a  daughter  called 
Acbamoth  (nioan,  Philosophy),  who,  being 
excluded  from  the  Pleroma,  descended  to  the 
rude  and  shapeless  mass  of  matter,  and  by 
the  help  of  Jesus  brought  forth  the  Demi- 
urge (Arj/iiioupyds,  Artificer).  This  Demi- 
urge separated  the  more  subtile  or  animal 
matter  from  the  grosser  or  material,  framing 
from  the  former  the  visible  heavens,  from 
the  latter  the  earth.  Men  he  compounded 
of  both  kinds  of  matter.  As  he  waxed 
insolent,  and  arrogated  to  himself  the  honours 
of  the  Supreme  God,  Christ  descended,  and, 
having  an  ethereal  body,  passed  through 
the  body  of  Mary  as  water  through  a  canal, 
to  whom  Jesus,  another  of  the  highest 
.ffions,  joined  himself  when  he  was  baptized 
in  Jordan  by  John.  The  Demiurge  caused 
him  to  be  crucified,  but  before  his  execution 
both  Jesus  and  the  rational  soul  forsook 
him,  so  that  only  his  essential  soul  and 
ethereal  body  were  suspended  on  the  cross. 
There  are  three  sorts  of  men — the  spiritual, 
material,  and  animal.  These  three  sub- 
stances were  united  together  in  Adam,  but 
they  were  divided  in  his  children.  That 
which  was  spiritual  went  into  Seth,  the 
material  into  Cain,  and  the  animal  into  Abel. 
The  spiritual  men  shall  be  immortal,  what- 
ever crimes  they  commit ;  the  material,  on 
the  contrary,  shall  be  annihilated,  whatever 
good  they  do ;  the  animal,  who  according  to 
the  precepts  of  Christ,  renounce  the  pagan 
deities  and  the  Jewish  God  may  be  admitted, 
if  they  do  good,  to  the  mansions  of  the 
blessed  near  the  Pleroma,  and  shall  be  anni- 
hilated if  they  do  evil. 

The  whole  system  of  Valentinus  seems 
full  of  the  grossest  absurdities,  but  we  must 
remember  that  we  learn  it,  not  from  his  own 
%vritings,  but  chiefly  from  those  of  his  oppo- 
nents. ■  These  were  Irenseus  (adv.  Hxres.), 
TertuUian  (adv.  Valen.,  where  the  heresy  is 
treated  in  a  tone  of  jesting  irony),  and 
Hippolytus  (Refut.  ornn.  Hseres.). — See 
Bishop  Kaye's  TertuUian,  509 ;  Rose's 
Neander,  ii.  70 ;  Stubbs'  Mosheim,  i.  148 ; 
Burton's  Bampton  Lectures.     [H.] 

VALENTINE,  ST. :  Bishop  and  martyr. 
He  greatly  assisted  the  martyrs  at  Eome  in 
the  persecution  under  Claudius  II.,  and  was 


VATICAN  COUNCIL 


759" 


himself  beheaded  on  the  14th  of  Februarj', 
c.  A.D.  270.  His  name  occurs  in  the  early 
sacramentaries.  1'he  custom  of  choosing 
"valentines"  appears  to  have  had  its  origin 
in  a  heathen  practice  connected  with  the 
worship  of  Juno,  on  or  about  this  day,  but 
is  in  no  way  connected  with  the  festival. — 
Alban  Butler's  lAves  of  Saints;  Annot.  P.  B. 
[41].    [H.] 

VALESIANS.  Christian  heretics,  dis- 
ciples of  Valesius,  an  Arabian  philosopher, 
who  appeared  about  the  year  250,  and  besides 
being  Gnostics,  maintained  that  concupi- 
scence acted  so  strongly  upon  man,  that  it 
was  not  in  his  power  to  resist  it,  and  that 
even  the  grace  of  God  was  not  suEBcient  to 
enable  him  to  get  the  better  of  it.  Upon 
this  principle  he  taught  that  the  only  way 
for  a  man  to  be  saved  was  to  make  himself 
an  eunuch.  The  Origenists  afterwards  fell 
into  the  same  error,  but  it  was  Valesius  who 
gave  birth  to  it.  The  bishop  of  Phila- 
delphia condemned  this  philosopher,  and  the 
other  Churches  of  the  East  followed  his 
example. 

The  Valesians  were  very  cruel.  They 
were  not  satisfied  to  mutilate  those  of  their 
sect,  but  they  had  the  barbarity  to  make 
eunuchs  of  strangers  who  chanced  to  pass 
by  where  they  lived.  This  heresy  spread 
greatly  in  Arabia,  and  especially  in  the  ter- 
ritory of  Philadelphia. — Epiphan.  Eseres. 
Iviii. ;  Aug.  Hxres.  xxvii. 

VATICAN  CODEX.  The  celebrated 
Greek  MS.  of  the  Bible,  known  as  Codex 
B  ;  numbered  1209  in  the  Vatican  Library ; 
one  of  the  three  oldest  vellum  MSS.  in  exis- 
tence, the  others  being  the  Alexandrian 
known  as  A,  and  the  Sinaitic  known  as  K 
(See  Bible).  Most  part  of  Genesis  is  want- 
ing, the  MS.  beginning  at  chapter  xlvi., 
verse  28,  and  there  are  several  deficiencies 
in  the  Psalms.  The  Pastoral  Epistles,  and 
the  book  of  Revelation,  are  altogether  want- 
ing, and  the  MS.  ends  at  Hebrews  ix.  14. 
It  is  written  on  veiy  thin  vellum,  in  small 
uncial  characters,  the  later  additions  being 
supplied  in  a  cursive  hand.  Cardinal  Mai's 
edition  was  issued  in  1857,  three  years  after 
the  cardinal's  death.  In  this  the  lacunaj 
in  the  original  are  supplied  from  other 
codices  in  the  Vatican  Library.  Thus  the 
Pastoral  Epistles  are  taken  from  MS.  1761, 
of  the  tenth  century,  and  the  Apocalypse 
from  MS.  2066,  attributed  to  the  eighth 
centuiy.  But  the  edition  falls  far  short  of 
what  had  been  expected. — Scrivener,  Intro, 
to  Study  of  the  N.  T.:  St.  Mark's  Gospel, 
Append.     [H.] 

VATICAN  COUNCIL,  THE.  This 
council  was  convoked  by  a  Bull  of  Pius  IX., 
June  29,  1868.  By  the  Romanists  it  was 
called  an  QScumenical  Council,  but  falsely  so, 
as  no  representatives  were  invited  from  the 


7G0 


VAUDOIS 


Eastern  or  the  Englisli  Church  (See  (Ecu- 
menical). The  first  meeting  was  held  on 
December  8,  1869,  when  amongst  other 
matters  that  for  which  the  council  had 
chiefly  been  convened — the  Infallibility  of 
the  Pope — was  discussed.  An  attempt  was 
made  to  prove  that  the  declaration  of  Papal 
Infallibility  was  in  harmony  with  the  utter- 
ances of  former  councils,  more  especially 
the  Council  of  Lyons,  a.d.  1274,  and  of 
Florence,  a.d.  1439 ;  but  the  arguments 
never  had  any  weight  with  scholars,  and 
were  shattered  by  Dr.  DoUinger,  who  in  a 
long  letter  published  in  the  German  press 
exposed  the  gross  inaccuracy  of  the  state- 
ments on  which  they  were  based.  The 
dogma  of  Infallibility  was  proclaimed  July 
18,  1870.  Out  of  '601  bishops  present  in 
Home  when  the  final  vote  was  taken,  535 
are  said  to  have  voted  "placet";  2  "non 
placet " ;  while  66  absented  themselves  from 
the  coimcil.  But  only  five  days  before 
(i.e.  on  July  13)  the  votes  are  said  to  have 
been,  "placet"  451 ;  "  non  placet"  88.  All 
that  can  certainly  be  affirmed  is,  that 
the  dogma  did  not  receive  the  unanimous 
assent  even  of  those  prelates  who  composed 
the  council,  while  a  large  number  of  the 
most  eminent,  especially  in  Germany,  France 
and  England,  offered  a  more  or  less  positive 
opposition.  The  council  was  suspended  bv  a 
Bull  of  Pius  IX.,  October  20, 1870  (See  in- 
fallibility, and  a  book  called  Janus  on  the 
Vatican  Council).     [W.  E.  W.  S.] 

VAUDOIS  (See  Waldenses). 

VAULT.  This  is  generally  taken  to 
mean  either  an  arched  stone  roof,  or  an 
imitation  of  some  of  its  usual  shapes  in 
either  visible  wood  or  wooden  framing 
plastered.  York  Minster  now  exhibits  aU 
of  them — ^viz.  stone  vaulting  in  all  the 
aisles,  plaster  imitation  of  stone  in  the  main 
roof  of  the  nave  and  choir  and  the  chapter 
house,  which  is  an  octagonal  dome  sixty- 
three  feet  wide,  and  the  south  transept  has 
been  very  unwisely  "  restored,"  as  Mr. 
Street  called  it,  with  visible  wood  vaulting 
instead  of  plaster,  which  had  long  existed. 
Everybody  complains  justly  that  the  altera- 
tion has  made  it  look  much  lower.  The 
modem  craze  for  destroying  plaster,  and 
leaving  rough  stonework  like  a  wall  in  a 
field,  which  Street  also  did  in  the  aisle 
vaults  of  that  transept,  is  the  result  of  pure 
ignorance  of  really  ancient  usage.  No  such 
walls  or  vaults  were  ever  left  in  fine 
churches.  The  inside  of  St.  Alban's  Cathe- 
dral, both  Norman  walls  and  vardts,  and  the 
Decorated  vault  of  the  south  aisle,  were  and 
are  plastered  all  over,  and  the  original  De- 
corated vault  of  the  choir  is  wood,  painted 
in  patterns,  of  which  the  ground  is  mainly 
white. 

Subject  to  these  qualifications,  we  may 


VAULT 

treat  vaulting  as  practically  a  stone  arched 
roof,  of  which  there  are  various  construc- 
tions belonging  to  the  different  styles  of 
architecture.  The  earliest  is  the  simple 
barrel  vault,  or  a  semi-cylinder  resting  all 
along  on  two  walls,  which  is  evidently 
subject  to  the  same  mechanical  conditions 
as  a  round  arch,  and  is  incapable  of  standing 
without  very  considerable  thickness,  if  it  is 
not  supported  by  abutments  a  good  way  up 
the  haunches.  In  fact  the  thickness  must 
not  be  less  than  a  22nd  of  the  diameter 
(see  chapter  on  Domes  in  the  "Book  on 
Building  ").  Accordingly  there  are  very  few 
barrel  vaults  of  any  great  width,  and  very 
few  Norman  vaults  at  all,  except  over 
aisles,  and  no  Saxon  ones  are  known.  More- 
over, there  is  another  fatal  impediment  to 
building  simply  bai'rel  vaults  over  clearstory 
windows,  except  small  ones  in  very  thick 
walls,  that  the  wall  over  the  windows  is 
incapable  of  affording  much  abutment.  In 
fact,  the  science  of  vaulting  may  be  said  to 
consist  of  knowing  how  to  carry  a  stone 
roof  only  on  the  unwindowed  parts  of  a  long 
wall,  which  may  be  called  piers  fortified  by 
flying  buttresses.  The  commonly  stated 
analogy  of  vaults  to  domes  is  a  false  one 
altogether,  and  the  mechanical  conditions 
are  quite  dififerent.  Every  horizontal  sec- 
tion of  a  dome  is  concave  inside,  but  no 
horizontal  section  of  a  vault  is.  Every 
lump  of  vaulting  springing  from  one  pier 
is  an  inverted,  hollow-sided  pyramid,  of 
which  the  horizontal  section  is  either  a 
rectangle,  or  a  polygon,  or  (in  fan  tracery) 
a  circle,  curved  the  opposite  way  from  a 
dome. 

We  can  only  give  a  verj'  cursory  account 
here  of  the  difl'erent  kinds  of  vaulting.  Our 
only  great  Norman  vault  is  at  Durham, 
where  the  ribs,  which  it  is  another  common 
error  to  consider  an  essential  part  of  a  vault, 
are  some  of  them  transverse  and  semi- 
circular, and  others  diagonal,  and  therefore 
necessarily  flatfish  semi-ellipses.  If  you 
were  to  build  a  complete  barrel  vault,  and 
then  pierce  it  through  over  every  window 
with  anothet  equal  one,  only  just  enough 
for  them  both  to  stand  on  at  the  piers,  the 
diagonal  edges  would  all  be  ellipses,  and  the 
whole  system  of  vaults  much  more  stable 
than  a  continuous  barrel  vault;  and  there 
would  be  no  thrust  over  the  windows, 
because  it  is  carried  to  the  piers  and  flying 
buttresses  between  the  windows.  The  ribs, 
which  were  added  in  all  grand  work,  but  very 
often  not  in  crypts,  and  kitchens,  and  other 
low  vaulted  rooms,  are  mainly  decorative, 
and  add  little  or  nothing  to  the  strength, 
unless  they  are  very  deep  themselves,  be- 
cause they  also  add  their  weight,  and  would 
not  stand  alone.  The  directly  transverse 
ribs  are  also   mainly   ornamental,  i.e.  the 


VAULT 

vault  coiild  stand  without  them,  though 
they  seem  to  carry  it. 

In  Early  English  and  Decorated  vaults  the 
transverse  section  and  ribs  became  pointed 
arches,  and  also  the  east  and  west  arches 
over  the  windows,  but  the  diagonal  ones 
are  flatter  arches  than  the  transverse,  being 
wider  vnth  the  same  height.  The  ribs 
themselves  are  always  made  in  one  plane, 
and  the  vaulting  sometimes  assumes  curious 
shapes  in  following  them.  They  are  gener- 
ally circular  in  sweep,  and  not  elliptical. 
The  middle  of  vaults  is  seldom  much  above 
the  top  of  the  arch  over  the  windows,  and 
may  indeed  be  lower.  Sometimes  there  is  a 
large  rib  running  right  along  the  top  from 
east  to  west,  which  again  is  merely  orna- 
mental, as  of  com^e  the  bosses  are  at  the 
various  intersections  of  ribs.  There  are  also 
often  a  multitude  of  other  ribs  in  various 
directions,  giving  a  beautiful  appearance  of 
a  stone  framework  all  mechanically  arranged 
in  the  direction  of  the  thrusts ;  and  vaulting 
is  generally  spoken  of  as  if  it  were  really  so, 
and  as  if  the  panelling  did  nothing  except 
fill  up  and  lie  on  the  ribs.  But  that  also  is 
all  a  mistake.  Without  the  panelling  the 
ribs  would  have  very  inadeq^uate  stabiUty, 
and  often  none  at  all.  Take  the  simple 
case  of  the  great  central  east  and  west  rib, 
in  such  vaults  as  Lichfield.  Eemove  the 
panelling,  which  forms  a  pointed  arch  up  to 
it  on  each  side ;  it  could  not  stand  without 
every  piece  of  it  being  arched  itself  from 
transverse  ribs,  and  so  of  all  other  ribs. 
When  there  are  shorter  ribs  than  the  main 
ones,  the  vaulting  is  called  lierne,  which 
seems  merely  to  mean  ribbed  or  bound 
together.  The  vault  of  the  choir  of  Lincoln, 
Irom  the  great  transept  to  the  small  one,  has 
a  fanciful  and  bewildering  peculiarity  in  the 
main  diagonal  ribs  not  meeting  each  other 
so  as  to  form  continuous  arches,  but  each 
meeting  the  next  but  one  to  its  proper 
opposite,  and  each  severy  of  the  vault  looks 
twisted,  as  if  the  south  clearstory  had  been 
pushed  westwards  relatively  to  the  north 
one,  though  the  windows  and  piers  are  really 
opposite  as  usuaL 

As  the  styles  advanced  there  was  a 
tendency  to  make  the  horizontal  sections 
right  through  all  the  vaulting  more  polygonal 
than  rectangular,  or,  as  we  may  say,  to 
round  or  chamfer  off  the  comers  where  the 
cross  vault  meets  the  main  ones ;  and  hence 
come  the  terms  "  quadripartite  and  sexpartite 
vaulting,"  according  to  the  number  of  faces 
of  the  vaulting  pyramids.  And  finally  this 
process  reached  its  climax  in  the  conoidal 
vaults  of  completely  circular  horizontal 
section  (i.e.  semicircular  rotmd  each  pier)  of 
the  well-known  "  fan  tracery "  of  King's 
College  Cliapel,  Bath  Abbey,  St.  Mary 
Eedclifte,  and  many  smaller  examples,  in 


VEIL 


7GI 


which  the  ribs  are  visibly  nothing  but 
ornamental  panelling,  generally  with  a  large 
boss  in  the  middle  to  fill  up  the  gap  where 
the  highest  circles  meet.  In  still  later 
examples,  such  as  Henry  A''II.'s  chapel  at 
Westminster,  and  St.  George's,  Windsor, 
the  central  bosses  become  deep  and  danger- 
ous looking  "  pendants,"  stuck  on  also  in 
other  places  where  they  are  not  wanted  at 
all,  but  are  a  base  addition,  meaning  nothing, 
and  entirely  unstructural,  whereas  all  genuine 
ornamentation  of  the  early  styles  meant 
something,  and  had  at  first  a  structural 
reason  and  appearance  of  use,  though 
perhaps  no  real  necessity.  Ean  tracery  was 
the  last,  and  we  may  say  the  only  invention 
of  the  Perpendicular  style,  and  then  it  began 
rapidly  to  decline  and  fall,  and  all  subse- 
quent architecture  became,  and  wOl  for  ever 
be,  mere  copying  of  old  forms,  with  more 
or  less  of  "  ecclecticism,"  except  the  mere 
displays  of  fantastic  ugliness  and  vulgarity 
which  modern  architects  try  to  pass  off  for 
originality.  This  is  of  course  equally  true 
of  the  Italian,  or  classical,  and  the  Gothic 
styles  as  used  now  (though  generally  .for- 
gotten).    [G.] 

The  word  "Vault"  is  also  commonly 
used  for  a  repository  of  the  dead ;  the  coffin 
being  placed  in  a  vaulted  tomb. 

*'  As  in  a  vault,  an  ancient  receptacle, 
■\Vbere,  for  these  many  hundred  years,  the  bones 
Of  all  my  buried  ancestors  are  pack'd." 

Shakespeare,  Romeo  and  Juliet,  iv.  3. 

VEIL.  1.  The  name  given  in  the  East  for 
our  "fair  linen  cloth"  with  wliich  the  con- 
secrated elements  are  covered. 

2.  Hangings  in  front  of  the  chancel  gate, 
used  in  old  times  partly  to  hide  the  sight 
of  the  east  end  from  the  catechumens 
and  unbelievers,  and  partly  to  cover  the 
sacrifice  of  the  Eucharist,  in  the  time 
of  consecration  (See  Ghrys.  Horn.  iii.  in 
EpJies.).  There  were  also  veils  before  the 
other  doors  of  a  church.  St.  Jerome  com- 
mends Nepotian  among  other  things,  for 
seeing  that  the  gates  had  their  veils 
(Hieron.  Epitaph.  Nepotian). 

3.  At  the  service  of  the  Churching  of 
Women,  the  woman  was  always  supposed 
to  wear  a  veil.  In  an  inventory  of  church 
goods  belonging  to  St.  Benet's,  Grace  Church, 
in  1560,  there  is  "  a  churching  cloth,  fringed," 
from  which  it  would  seem  that  the  veil  was 
in  some  cases  provided  by  the  church.  In 
Archdeacon  Hale's  Precedents  there  are 
several  presentations  of  clergymen  for  re- 
fusing to  church  women  who  did  not  wear 
VQ'Hi.—Annot.  P.  B.  (See  Churching). 

4.  Brida,l  veils  are  of  great  antiquity. 
St.  Ambrose  speaks  of  the  custom  of 
veiling  when  he  says  the  Christian  marriage 
ought  to  be  sanctified  with  the  sacerdotal 
veil,  and  benediction — "Cum  ipsum  con- 


762 


VENI 


jugium  velamine  sacerdotali  et  benedictione 
saDctifioari  oporteat  {Ep.  70). 

5.  Paten  and  Chalice  veils.  A  square  of 
silk,  of  a  colour  in  accordance  with  the 
season,  with  which  the  paten  and  chalice 
are  covered.  They  were  always  of  the  best 
mateiials  that  could  be  got  (Renaudot, 
Lit.  Or.  i.  304 :  IL  61).     [H.] 

VENI,  CREATOR  SPIRITUS.  A  hymn 
to  the  Holy  Ghost,  used  in  our  Ordinal 
before  the  laying  on  of  hands  at  the  or- 
dination of  priests,  and  consecration  of 
bishops.  It  is  undoubtedly  of  great  an- 
tiquity, and  is  generally  ascribed  to  St. 
Ambrose  in  the  Iburth  century.  But  the 
Benedictine  editors  of  Ambrose's  works  do 
not  think  there  is  sufficient  evidence  for 
the  fact.  It  is  published  by  Thoraasius 
amongst  the  collection  of  ancient  hymns 
used  in  the  Western  Churches  (Thom.  Op. 
a  bezzosi,  torn.  ii.  p.  375),  and  in  the 
Pontifical  of  Soisson,  which  dates  from  the 
eleventh  century  (Martene,  torn.  ii.  p.  50). 
In  the  Salisbury  and  Paris  Breviary  it  is 
set  down  as  a  hymn  for  Pentecost.  It 
was  introduced  into  the  ordination  service 
probably  in  the  eleventh  century.  The  first 
version  given  in  our  Prayer  Book  was 
inserted  in  1661 ;  the  second  version,  which 
is  an  expansion  rather  than  a,  translation, 
is  the  earlier,  having  been  inserted  in  1549, 
and  revised  in  1661. — Palmer,  Orig.  Liturg. 
ii.  295  ;  Maskell,  Mon.  Mt.  ii.  223.     [H.] 

VENITE,  EXULTEMUS.  "0  come,  let 
us  sing"  (Ps.  95).  This  psalm  from  very 
early  times  has  been  placed  before  the 
psalms  of  the  nocturn,  in  the  Western 
Churches.  St.  Athanasius  says  that  before 
the  beginning  of  their  prayers  the  Christians 
(of  Constantinople)  invited  and  exhorted  one 
another  in  the  words  of  this  psalm.  St. 
Augustine  also  refers  to  it,  and  Amalarius 
later  on  (820)  speaks  of  it  as  being  sung  on 
Sundays  at  the  beginning  of  nocturns 
(Amalar.  de  Eccl.  Off.  hb.  iv.  c.  9).  In 
Henry  VIII.'s  Primer  it  is  entitled  "A 
Song  stirring  to  the  praise  of  God " ;  in 
other  ancient  English  offices  it  is  called  the 
invitatory  psalm.     [H.] 

VENIAL  SIN.  The  Church  of  Rome, 
following  the  schoolmen,  represents  some 
sins  as  pardonable,  and  others  not.  The 
first  they  call  venial,  the  second,  mortal, 
sins.  Thomas  Aquinas  makes  seven  dis- 
tinctions in  sin  (See  Sin"). 

VERNACULAR  (Lat.,  from  verna,  a 
slave  born  in  the  house).  The  common 
language  of  a  country.  Our  Article  (xxiv.) 
.speaks  of  having  public  prayer  or  adminis- 
tering the  sacraments  in  a  tongue  not  under- 
stavded  of  the  people,  as  repugnant  to  the 
Word  of  God.  It  is  evident  that  in  the 
time  of  the  Fathers  the  vernacular  "  under- 
standed  of  the  people  "  was  only  used.     After 


VERSE 

a  time  not  a  foreign  language  but  a  lo^v 
tone  of  voice  seems  to  have  been  adopted  in 
some  places  by  the  priests,  for  in  the  civil 
law  it  was  ordered :  "  We  will  and  com- 
mand that  all  bishops  and  priests  celebrate 
the  Holy  Eucharist  not  in  a,  low  voice, 
but  in  a  loud  and  clear  voice,  which  may 
be  heard  by  the  faithful,  that  thereby  the- 
minds  of  the  hearers  may  be  raised  with 
greater  devotion  to  set  forth  the  praises  of 
the  Lord  God ;  for  so  doth  the  Apostle  teach 
us  in  his  first  Epistle  to  the  Corinthians"' 
(Justin.  Novell.  123,  137).  In  England  the 
intelligent  use  of  the  services  by  the  people: 
was  always  encouraged,  and  herein  her 
Church  differed  considerably  from  other 
European  Churches.  In  a.d.  740,  Egbert,, 
archbishop  of  York,  ordered  that  "every 
priest  do  instil  the  Lord's  Prayer  and  Creed 
into  the  people  entrusted  to  him."  TwO' 
centuries  later  JSMnc,  archbishop  of  Canter- 
bury, enjoined  the  clergy  to  "speak  the 
sense  of  the  Gospel  to  the  people  in  English,, 
and  of  the  Pater  Noster  and  of  the  Creed  " 
(Johnson's  Eng.  Canons,  i.  186,  248,  398). 
Similar  injunctions  are  to  be  found  ia 
Peckham's  Constitutions,  and  in  the  canons 
of  many  diocesan  synods  in  the  mediseval 
period.— Blunt's  Diet.  Docf.  783.     [H.] 

VERGER  (from  virga,  a  rod).  It  clearly 
ought  to  be  spelt  Virger.  He  who  carries 
the  mace  before  the  dean  or  canons  in  a 
cathedral  or  collegiate  church.  In  some- 
cathedrals  the  dean  has  his  owu  verger,  the 
canons  theirs:  in  others  the  verger  goes- 
before  any  member  of  the  church,  whether- 
capitular  or  not,  when  he  leaves  his  place 
to  perform  any  part  of  the  service.  An 
officer  of  a  similar  title  precedes  the  vice- 
chancellor  in  the  English  universities,  but  is- 
there  called  'an  esquire  bedel,'  hedellus. 
The  inferior  ones  are  called '  yeoman  bedels,'' 
at  Cambridge. 

VERSE.  A  line  or  short  sentence,, 
generally  applied  to  poetry,  but  also  ap- 
plicable to  prose,  as  Cicero  employs  it.  See 
Facciolati  in  voc.  Hence  it  came  to  mean, 
a  short  sentence.  It  has,  in  an  ecclesiastical 
sense,  these  several  meanings  : 

1.  The  short  paragraphs,  numbered  for 
the  sake  of  reference,  into  which  the  Bible- 
is  at  present  divided,  are  called  verses. 
These  divisions  were  introduced  into  the- 
Old  Testament  by  Rabbi  Nathan,  in  the 
fifteenth  century.  Those  in  the  New  were 
introduced  by  Robert  Stephens  in  1551. 

2.  The  short  sentence  of  the  minister, 
which  is  followed  by  the  response  of  the 
choir  or  people,  in  the  Latin  ritual.  These 
are  marked  V.  &  R.  It  is  something  like- 
the  versicles  in  our  service,  but  is  frequently 
longer. 

3.  A  sentence  or  short  anthem,  as  in  the- 
Introits  of  the  Latin  service. 


YERSICLES 

4.  Verse  in  the  Englisli  choral  service 
means  those  passages  in  the  hymns  or 
anthems  ivhich  are  sung  by  a  portion  only 
of  the  choir,  sometimes  by  a  single  voice, 
as  contradistinguished  from  the  full  parts, 
or  chorus.  Thus  we  have  full  and  verse 
anthems. 

VERSICLES.  Short  or  diminutive 
vei-ses,  said  alternately  by  the  minister  and 
people;  such,  for  example,  as  the  fol- 
lowing : — 

Min.  0  Lord,  show  thy  mercy  upon  us  ; 

Ans.  And  grant  us  thy  salvation. 

Min.  0  God,  make  clean  our  hearts 
within  us ; 

Ans.  And  take  not  thy  Holy  Spirit  from 
us. 

The  versicles,  properly  so  called  (with 
their  responses)  are  in  most  instances  pas- 
sages from  the  Psalms,  and  are  thus  dis- 
tinguished from  other  suffrages,  which  are 
neither  verses  from  the  Psalms,  nor  form 
in  each  petition  and  response  a  continuous 
sentence.  In  the  Litany  the  two  versicles 
with  their  responses.  "  0  Lord,  deal  not 
with  us  after  our  sins,"  and  "0  Lord,  let 
thy  mercy  he  shewed  upon  us,"  are  dis- 
tinguished from  the  other  suffrages  (in  the 
Litany)  by  having  the  words  Priest  and 
Answer  prefixed ;  and  by  being  each  a 
verse  from  the  Psalms.  To  which  may  be 
added,  that  till  the  last  Eeview,  these  had 
been  always  prefaced  in  the  English  Litany, 
since  the  Reformation,  by  the  words  "  the 
versicles." 

VERSIONS  OP  SCRIPTURE  (See 
Bitle ;  Targum, ;  Feshito). 

VESICA  PISCIS  (See  Fiscis). 

VESPERS,  or  EVENSONG,  is  men- 
tioned by  the  most  ancient  Fathers,  and  it 
is  probable  that  the  custom  of  holding  an 
assembly  for  pubhc  worship  at  this  time 
is  of  the  most  primitive  antiquity.  Cer- 
tainly in  the  fourth  century,  and  perhaps 
in  the  third,  there  was  public  evening 
service  in  the  Eastern  Churches,  as  we 
leam  from  the  Apostolical  Constitutions ; 
and  Cassian,  in  the  beginning  of  the  fifth 
century,  appears  to  refer  the  evening  and 
noctural  assemblies  of  the  Egyptians  to  the 
time  of  St.  Mark  the  Evangelist. 

VESTMENTS.  VESTURES  (Lat.  ws- 
timentum,  from  vestire,  to  clothe).  Gar- 
ments. Ecclesiastical  vestments  are  articles 
of  dress  or  ornament,  worn  by  ministers  in 
the  celebration  of  Divine  service.  It  has 
been  supposed  by  some  that  the  Christian 
vestments  were  adopted  from  those  used  in 
the  Levitical  Church,  but  this  does  not 
appear  probable.  There  seems,  in  fact, 
to  have  been  originally  but  little  resem- 
blance. The  dress  worn  by  Christian  mini- 
sters in  primitive  times  was  chiefly  white, 
that  in  the  Jewish  Church  highly  coloured 


VESTMENTS 


76* 


(Marriott's  Vest.  Christ.);  nothing  really 
resembling  the  Jewish  mitre  apjjears  among 
Christian  ornaments,  till  towards  mediaaval 
times,  when  the  mitre  was  used  (see 
Mitre);  the  girdle,  so  important  in  the 
Jewish  priestly  vestures,  is  not  early  known 
as  a  Christian  vestment  in  the  shape  which 
it  took  about  the  sixth  and  the  eighth  cen- 
turies ;  and  the  chasuble,  called  the  vest- 
ment in  Christian  Churches,  has  no  great 
resemblance  to  anything  worn  by  the  Le- 
vitical priests.  On  the  other  hand  the- 
vestments  are  similar  to  the  ordinary  dress 
of  the  Romans  and  Easterns  in  the  early 
times.  In  the  albe  we  liave  the  tunic ;. 
the  psenula,  after  the  fashion  of  the  toga 
had  gone  out,  was  the  super-vestment,  often 
mentioned  by  heathen  writers,  frequently 
with  an  additional  ornament — the  orarium 
(stole) ;  the  dalmatic  was  used  by  a  Romait 
emperor ;  the  cope  had  a  similar  origin ; 
the  maniple  was  a  handkerchief  carried  in' 
the  hand  ;  and  the  pallimn,  omophorion,  &c., 
are  modifications  of  that  which  is  known 
now  simply  as  the  stole  (See  Planeta,  Stole^ 
Maniple,  Cope).  That  such  vestments  were 
used  in  early  times  seems  certain,  and  in 
the  4th  coxmcil  of  Toledo  (a.d.  633)  they 
are  referred  to  as  being  ordinarily  worn. 
Because  they  were  derived  from  the  Roman 
dress,  which  was  adopted  by  aU  who  came- 
under  the  Roman  civilization,  and  under 
the  Constantinopolitan  emperors,  it  cannot 
be'said  that  they  are  in  themselves  badges 
of  the  Roman  Church.  The  English 
Church,  despite  many  endeavours  on  the- 
part  of  the  pope's  adherents,  was  never 
subject  to  the  bishop  of  Rome.  The  Eng- 
lish "  uses"  differed  from  the  Roman  ritual, 
and  in  the  "  Sarum  Use  "  the  colours  used 
at  different  seasons  in  the  ornaments  and 
vestments,  were  not  identical  with  those  of 
Rome. 

The  vestments  that  were  used  in  the 
Communion  Service  at  the  time  of  the  Re- 
formation are  described  by  Archbishop 
Cranmer  or  under  his  directions,  in  a  book 
called  the  "  Rationale  of  the  Ceremonies- 
to  he  used  in  the  Church  of  England,  with 
an  explanation,"  &c.  There  is  (1)  the 
Amice,  a  broad  and  oblong  piece  of  linen' 
with  two  strings  to  fasten  it  (See  Amice). 
The  explanation  of  this  is,  "  He  (the  cele- 
brant) putteth  on  the  Amice,  which  as 
touching  the  mystery,  signifies  the  veil 
with  the  which  the  Jews  covered  the  face  of 
Christ  when  they  buffeted  Him  in  the  time 
of  His  Passion.  And  as  touching  the- 
minister,  it  signifies  faith,  which  is  the  head, 
ground,  and  foundation  of  all  virtues ;  and 
therefore  he  puts  that  upon  his  head  first." 
(2)  The  Albe  (see  Alhe),  "  which,  as  touch- 
ing the  mystery,  signifieth  the  white  garment 
wherewith  Herod  clothed  Christ  in  mockery 


764 


VESTMENTS 


when  he  sent  Him  to  Pilate.    And  as  toucli- 
ing  the  minister,  it  signifieth  the  pureness 
of  conscience,  and  innoceucy  he  ought  to 
have."    (3)  The  Girdle,  a  cord  or  narrow 
band  of  silk  or  other  material  (see  Girdle), 
which  fastened  the  albe  rovmd  the  waist, 
which  is  explained  thus  :  "  The  Girdle,  as 
touching  the  mystery,  signifies  the  scourge 
with  which  Christ  was  scourged.     And  as 
touching  the  minister,  it  signifies  the  con- 
tinent and  chaste  living,  or  else  the  close 
mind  which  he  ought  to  have  at  prayers, 
when  he  celebrates."    (4)  The  Stole  (see 
Stole),  which,  "as  touching  the  mystery, 
signiiieth  the  ropes  or  bands  that  Christ 
was  bound  with  to  the  pillar,  when  He  was 
scourged.     And  as   touching  the  minister, 
it  signifieth  the  yoke  of  patience,  which  he 
mvist  bear  as  the  servant  of  God."    (5)  The 
Maniple    (see    Maniple),    called    in    the 
Rationale,  the  "Phanon,"  which  the  cele- 
brant "  puts  on  his  arm,  which  admonisheth 
him  of  ghostly  strength,  and  godly  patience 
that  he  ought  to  have  to  vanquish  and  over- 
come all  infirmity."    (6)  The  Chasuble  or 
particular  vestment  (see  Chasvhle),  of  which 
it  is  said  in  the  Rationale  "  the  over  ves- 
ture, or  chesible,  as  touching  the  mystery, 
signifieth   the  pm-ple  mantle  that  Pilate's 
soldiers  pu:t  upon  Christ  after  that  they  had 
scourged  Him.    And  as  touching  the  minis- 
ter, it  signifies  charity,  a  virtue  excellent 
above  all  other."    The  Cope,  and  the  Tu- 
nicle  are  not  mentioned  in  the  Rationale  of 
Craimier,  probably  because  they  were  not 
connected  with  the  vestments  in  which  the 
priest  celebrated  (See  Cope ;  Tunide).    But 
in  the  rubric  of  1549  (Edward's  First  Prayer 
Book)  the  mention  of  a  "  vestment  or  cope  " 
implies  that  the  chasuble  or  cope  was  to  be 
used  according  to  the  pm-pose  of  the  cele- 
brant to  consecrate  the  Sacrament  or  not  be 
used  at  the  discretion  of  the  minister.     One 
of  the  "  Certain  Notes  "  in  the  First  Prayer 
Book  of  Edward.  VI.  is  this,  "  And  whenso- 
ever the  bishop   shall   celebrate  the  holy 
Communion  in  the  church,  or  execute  any 
■other  public  ministration,  he  shall    have 
upon  him,  beside  his  rochette,  a  surpleis 
or  albe,  and  a  cope  or  vestmente,  and  also 
his  pastoral  staffe  in  his  hande  or  else  borne 
or  holden  by  his  chaplain."   A  rubric  before 
the  Communion  office  runs  thus,  "Upon  the 
•day,  and  at   the   time  appointed   for  the 
ministration  of  the  holy  Communion,  the 
priest  that  shall  execute  the  holy  ministry, 
shall  put  upon  him  the  vesture  appointed 
for  that  ministration;    that  is   to   say,  a 
white  albe  plain,  with  a  vestment  or  cope. 
And  where  there  be  many  priests,  or  deacons, 
there  so  many  shall  be  ready  to  help  the 
priest  in  the  ministration,  as  shall  be  re- 
■quisite ;  and  shall  have  upon  them  likewise 
the  vestures  appointed  for  their  ministry. 


VESTMENTS 

that  is  to  say  albes  with  tunacles."    It  is 
clear  that  here  it  was  intended   that   the 
celebrant  should  wear  (1)  a  linen  albe,  and 
(2)  over  it  the  vestment,  namely,  the  chasu- 
ble,   tlie  characteristic  eucharistic  robe  of 
all  Christendom,  dating  from  the  earliest 
ages  of  the  Church.     A  rubric  at  the  end  of 
the  Communion  Service  directs  that  when 
there  "  were  none  to  communicate  with  the 
priest,"  he  was  to  "  put  upon  him  a  plain 
albe  or  surpleis,  with  a  cope,"  and  not  to 
consecrate  the  Sacrament.     These  were  the 
necessary  vestments  (though  others  might 
be    used),  and  they  were  insisted  on  in 
after  times.     According  to  Statute  1  Eliz. 
c.  2  (1559),  it  was  enacted  "  that  such  orna- 
ments of  the  church,  and  of  the  ministers 
thereof,  shall  be  retained  and  be  in  use,  as 
was  in  this  Church  of  England  by  authority 
of  Parliament,  in  the  second  year  of  the 
reign  of  King  Edward  VI.,  until  other  order 
shall  be  therein  taken  by  the  authority 
of  the  Queen's  Majesty,  with  the  advice  of 
her  commissioners  appointed  and  authorized 
under  the  great  seal  of  England,  for  causes 
ecclesiastical,  or  of  the  Metropolitan  of  this 
Realm."    The  words  "  until  other  order  be 
taken  "  opens  the  question  of  Queen  Eliza- 
beth's Advertisements,  with  regard  to  which 
there  has  been  much  controversy  (See  Ad- 
vertisements).   The   Prayer  Book  of  1604 
ordered  "  that  the  minister  at  the  time  of 
the  Communion,  and  at  all  other  times  in 
his  ministration  shall  use  such  ornaments 
in  the  Chm-ch  as  were  in  use  by  authority 
of  Parliament  in  the   second   year  of  the 
reign  of  King  Edward  the  Sixth,"  and  that  of 
1662  ordered  "  that  such  ornaments  of  the 
Church   and   of  the  ministers  thereof,  at 
all  times   of   their   ministration,  shall   be 
retained,  and  be  in  use  as  were   in  this 
Church  of  England,   by  the  authority  of 
Parliament,  in  the  2nd  year  of  the  reign  of 
King  Edward  VL"     The  question  of  vest- 
ments gave  great  trouble   to    Archbishop 
Parker,  and  it  has  been  a  matter  of  con- 
troversy ever    since    that    time.    At  the 
present  day  there  are  Protestant  associa- 
tions   to    do    away    with    the    vestments 
allowed  or  ordered  by  Edward  VI.'s  first 
Prayer  Book.     But  in  the  older  times  the 
Puritans,  as  they  were  called,  went  to  even 
further  lengths.  The  surplice  and  the  "  comer 
cap,"  i.e.  the  cap  of  the  \iniversities,  were 
looked  upon  as  abominations  of  the  Church 
of  Rome.    They  were  called  the  "defiled 
robes  of  Antichrist,"  and  many  of  the  clergy 
gave  in  to  the  prevailing   opinion.      The 
consequence  was  that  other  holy  things  also 
were   treated  mth  irreverence.     Common 
basons  were  used  instead  of  fonts  at  baptism, 
and  the  religious  observance  of  the  Lord's 
supper  became  in  many  places  a  mere  form. 
Queen  Ehzabeth  however  insisted  upon  a 


VESTEY 

reverent  solemnization  of  the  rites  of  the 
Church,  and  under  the  rule  of  Archbishop 
Parker,  matters  were  brought  to  a  satisfac- 
tory couclusion.  It  was  the  evident  in- 
tention of  oui-  ecclesiastical  rulers  to  reform, 
not  to  destroy.  They  continually  bore  in 
mind  that  they  were  reforming  the  old 
Church,  and  not  establishing  a  new  sect. 
Bishop  Jewell,  Gheast,  and  even  Horn,  the 
Puritan  bishop  of  Winchester,  realised  this 
principle,  and  became  aware  that,  although 
the  popular  cry  was  against  vestments,  it 
was  not  really  directed  against  those  things, 
in  themselves  immaterial,  but  against  the 
whole  system  of  episcopacy  in  the  Church. 
It  is  not  necessary  to  follow  the  controversy 
throughout.  For  many  years  the  surplice 
was  considered  the  only  necessary  vestment. 
But  when  there  came  a  revival  with  regard 
to  Church  ritual  in  1830,  many  persons 
looking  to  King  Edward's  first  Prayer  Book, 
adopted  the  use  of  a  vestment,  or  chasuble 
over  an  albe;  and  the  practice  extended 
itself  partly  in  consequence  of  the  Judicial 
Committee  of  the  Privy  Council  having 
stated  in  1857  "  the  same  dresses  (and  the 
same  utensils  or  articles)  which  were  used 
under  the  First  Prayer  Book  of  Edward  Vlth. 
may  still  be  used."  '  Others,  foUoiving  in 
their  steps,  adopted  other  vestments,  e.g. 
the  amice  and  maniple,  which  are  not  men- 
tioned in  that  Prayer  Book.  This  has  caused 
much  litigation ;  Sir  E.  Phillimore  In  1870 
based  his  judgment  in  favour  of  the  vest- 
ments and  other  ornaments  upon  the  lan- 
guage of  the  Privy  Council  in  1857.  But 
his  judgment  was  reversed  by  the  Privy 
Council  in  1871,  which  then,  and  also  in 
1877,  declared  all  vestments,  except  the 
surplice,  to  be  illegal. — Strype's  Parker,  i. 
302,  485;  Fuller's  Cli.  Hist.  76;  Neale's 
Eist.  Pur.  i.  153 ;  Hook's  Archbishops,  ix. 
269,  389;  Palmer's  Orig.  Liturg.  ii.  309; 
Perry  in  Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.    [H.] 

VESTEY  (Anciently  Revestry  or  So- 
cristy).  A  room  attached  to  a  church 
for  the  keeping  of  the  vestments  and  the 
sacred  vessels.  The  most  usual  place  for 
the  vestry  was  at  the  north  side  of  the 
chancel,  at  the  east  end.  There  was  not 
infrequently  an  altar  in  the  vestry;  and 
sometimes  it  was  arranged  with  an  addi- 
tional chamber,  so  as  to  form  a  domus 
indusa  for  the  residence  of  an  ofiioiating 
priest. 

And  from  their  meeting  in  this  room, 
certain  assemblies  of  the  parishioners,  for 
the  despatch  of  the  official  business  of  the 
parish,  are  called  vestries  or  vestry  meet- 
ings. It  is  not,  however,  essential  to  the 
validity  of  the  meeting,  that  it  should  be 
held  in  the  vestry  of  the  church.  It  may  be 
convened  in  any  place  in  the  parish,  pro- 
vided the  parishioners  have  free  access  to 


VESTEY 


765 


it,  even  though  the  place  fixed  on  be 
private  property.  Notice  of  meeting  must 
be  given  three  days  previously,  by  affixing 
on  or  near  the  doors  of  all  churches  or 
chapels  within  the  parish,  a  printed  or 
written  notice.  Tlie  incumbent  is  ex  officio 
chairman  of  the  meeting.  All  persons,  male 
and  female,  rated  to  the  rehef  of  the  poor, 
whether  inhabitants  of  the  parish  or  not,  are 
entitled  to  attend  the  vestry  and  vote 
thereat :  and  this  right  is  also  extended  to 
all  inhabitants  coming  into  the  parish  since 
the  last  rate  for  the  relief  of  the  poor,  if  they 
consent  to  be  rated.  But  no  person  is  en- 
titled to  vote,  who  shall  have  neglected  or 
refused  to  pay  any  rate  which  may  be  due, 
and  shall  have  been  demanded  of  him,  nor 
is  he  entitled  to  be  present  at  any  vestry 
meeting.  A  motion  to  adjourn  the  vestry 
for  six  or  twelve  months,  or  for  any  time, 
with  a  view  to  defeat  the  object  of  the 
meeting,  is  illegal,  and  therefore  no  such 
motion  should  be  allowed  by  the  chairmjin. 

The  functions  of  vestries,  since  the -aboli- 
tion of  compulsory  church-rates  in  1868,  are 
to  elect  churchwardens,  to  present  for  ap- 
pointment fit  persons  as  overseers  of  the 
poor,  to  administer  the  property  of  the 
parish,  and  (if  so  appointed  under  local  Acts) 
to  suprintend  the  paving  and  lighting  of  the 
parish,  and  to  levy  rates  for  those  purposes. 

The  remedy  for  neglect  of  duty  by  a 
vestry  is  a  mandamus  from  the  Court  of 
Queen's  Bench,  directed  to  the  officer 
whose  duty  it  would  be  to  perform  the 
particular  act,  or  in  some  cases  by  an 
ordinary  process  against  him,  or  by  a 
process  against  the  churchwardens  out  of 
the  ecclesiastical  courts. 

In  the  year  1818  was  passed  the  58 
Geo.  III.  c.  69,  making  general  regula- 
tions for  the  holding  of  vestries,  and  this 
Act  was  amended  next  year  by  the  59 
Geo.  III.  c.  85.  In  the  same  year  was 
passed  the  59  Geo.  III.  c.  12,  commonly 
called  Sturges  Bourne's  Act,  authorising 
the  formation  of  select  vestries  for  the 
management  of  the  relief  of  paupers ;  but 
that  is  superseded  by  the  Poor  Law  Amend- 
ment Act  of  1834. 

The  1  &  2  Wm.  IV.  c.  20  was  an  im- 
portant Act  relating  to  vestries,  commonly 
called  Hobhouse's  Act.  It  authorises, 
upon  the  petition  of  a  certain  number  of 
parishioners  paying  rates,  the  formation  of 
a  representative  select  vestry.  To  1000 
ratepayers  12  representatives  are  allowed; 
above  1000,  24  ;  above  2000,  36  ;  and  so 
on,  allowing  12  additional  representatives 
for  every  additional  1000  ratepayers,  until 
the  number  of  the  select  vestry  reaches 
120,  which  is  the  limit  of  elected  members. 
There  are  others  ex  officio,  including  the 
clergy  of  the  district.     Section  40  of  this 


7CG 


VESTEY 


Act  saves  all  ecclesiastical  jurisdiction,  and 
provides  that  the  Act  shall  not  invalidate 
or  avoid  any  ecclesiastical  law  or  constitu- 
tion of  the  Church  of  England,  save  as 
concerns  the  appointment  of  vestries.  It  is 
repealed  as  to  the  metropolis  and  other 
arrangements  for  metropohtan  vestries  (not 
under  special  Acts  as  Marylehone  is)  made 
by  18  &  19  Vict.  c.  120.  And  by  c.  112  of 
the  following  year,  other  powers  "not  re- 
lating to  the  affairs  of  the  Church,"  are 
given  to  the  vestries  constituted  thereunder. 
These  Acts  do  not  affect  the  power  of  rate- 
payers to  elect  the  incumbent,  where  they 
unfortunately  have  it. 

A  series  of  church-building  Acts,  eighteen 
in  number,  were  passed  between  1818  and 
1848,  beginning  with  the  58  Geo.  III., 
And  ending  with  the  11  &  12  Vict.  They 
contained  clauses  which  provided  for  the 
formation  of  select  vestries  in  the  new 
ecclesiastical  districts  constituted  by  those 
Acts.  In  1851  came  the  14  &  15  Vict. 
c.  97,  which  enumerates  all  these  Acts, 
and  by  section  20  not  only  forbids  the 
formation  of  select  vestries  in  new  districts 
to  be  formed,  but  abolishes  all  those  which 
had  been  formed  under  the  Acts  enumer-" 
ated. 

By  the  Metropolitan  Burials  Act  of  1852 
(15  &  16  Vict.  c.  85,  amended  and  extended 
by  16  &  17  Vict.  c.  134)  new  and  import- 
ant duties  were  thrown  upon  vestries.  It 
is  therein  provided,  that,  upon  the  requisi- 
tion in  writing  of  ten  or  more  ratepayers 
of  any  parish  in  the  metropolis  in  which 
the  place  or  places  of  burial  shall  appear 
to  such  ratepayers  insufficient  or  danger- 
ous to  health  (and  whether  any  order  in 
council  in  relation  to  any  bmial  ground 
in  such  parish  has  or  has  not  been  made), 
the  churchwardens  or  other  persons  to 
whom  it  belongs  to  convene  meetings  of 
the  vestry  of  such  parish,  shall  convene  a 
meeting  of  the  vestry,  for  the  special 
purpose  of  determining  whether  a  burial 
gi-ound  shall  be  provided  under  this  Act 
ibr  the  parish  ;  and  pubhc  notice  of  such 
■vestry  meeting,  and  the  place  and  hour  of 
holding  the  same,  and  the  special  purpose 
thereof,  shall  be  given  in  the  usual  manner 
in  which  notices  of  the  meetings  of  the 
vestry  are  given,  at  least  seven  days  before 
holding  such  vestry  meeting ;  and  if  it 
be  resolved  by  the  vestry  that  a  burial 
ground  shall  be  provided  under  this  Act 
for  the  parish,  a  copy  of  such  resolution, 
extracted  from  the  minutes  of  the  vestiy, 
and  signed  by  the  chairman,  shall  be  sent 
to  one  of  her  Majesty's  principal  secretaries 
of  state. 

In  case  of  such  resolution  as  aforesaid, 
the  vestry  shall  appoint  not  less  than 
three,  nor  more  than  nine  persons,  being 


VESTKY 

ratepayers  of  the  paiish,  to  be  the  burial 
board  of  such  parish,  of  whom  one  third, 
or  as  nearly  as  may  be  one  third  (to  be 
determined  among  themselves),  shall  go 
out  of  office  yearly,  at  such  time  as  shall 
be  from  time  to  time  fixed  by  the  vestry, 
but  shall  be  eligible  for  immediate  re- 
appointment :  provided  always,  that  the 
incumbent  of  the  parish  shall  be  eligible 
to  be  appointed  and  re-appointed  from 
time  to  time  as  one  of  the  members  of  the 
said  board,  although  not  a  ratepayer  of  the 
parish ;  provided  also,  that  any  member 
of  the  board  may  at  any  time  resign  his 
office,  on  giving  notice  in  writing  to  the 
churchwardens  or  persons  to  whom  it 
belongs  to  convene  meetings  of  the  vestry. 

Any  vacancies  in  the  board  may  be  filled 
up  by  the  vestry  when  and  as  the  vestry 
shall  think  fit. 

The  board  shall  meet  at  least  once  in 
every  month  at  their  office,  or  some  other 
convenient  place,  previously  publicly  noti- 
fied, and  the  said  board  may  meet  at  such 
other  time  as  at  any  previous  meeting 
shall  be  determined  upon :  and  it  shall  be 
at  all  times  competent  for  any  two  mem- 
bers of  the  board,  by  writing  under  their 
hands,  to  summon,  with  at  least  forty-eight 
hours'  notice,  the  board  for  any  special 
purpose  mentioned  in  such  writing,  and  to 
meet  at  such  times  as  shall  be  a^jpointed 
therein. 

At  all  meetings  of  the  board,  any  num- 
ber not  less  than  three  members  of  such 
board  shall  be  a  sufficient  number  for 
transacting  business,  and  for  exercising  all 
the  powers  of  the  board. 

The  board  shall  appoint,  and  may  re- 
move at  pleasure,  a  clerk,  and  such  other 
officers  and  servants  as  shall  be  necessary 
for  the  business-  of  the  board,  and  for  the 
purposes  of  their  burial  ground;  and,  ivith 
the  approval  of  the  vestry,  may  appoint 
reasonable  salaries,  wages,  and  allowances 
for  such  clerk,  officers,  and  servants,  and, 
when  necessary,  may  hire  and  rent  a  suf- 
ficient office  for  holding  their  meetings  and 
transacting  their  business. 

Entries  of  all,  proceedings  of  the  board, 
with  the  names  of  the  members  who  attead 
each  meeting,  shall  be  made  in  books  to 
be  provided  and  kept  for  that  purpose, 
under  the  direction  of  the  board,  and  shall 
be  signed  by  the  members  present,  or  any 
two  of  them ;  and  all  entries  purporting 
to  be  so  signed  shall  be  received  as  evi- 
dence, without  proof  of  any  meeting  of  the 
board  having  been  duly  convened  or  held, 
or  of  the  presence  at  any  such  meeting  of 
the  persons  named  in  any  such  entry  as 
being  present  thereat,  or  of  such  persons 
being  members  of  the  board,  or  of  the 
signature    of   any    person  by  whom   any 


VESTRY 

such  entry  purports  to  be  sigued,  all  which 
matters  shall  be  presumed  until  the  con- 
trary be  proved ;  and  the  board  shall  provide 
and  keep  books  in  which  shall  be  entered 
true  and  regular  accounts  of  all  sums  of 
money  received  and  paid,  for  or  on  account 
•of  the  purposes  of  this  Act  in  the  parish,  and 
of  all  liabilities  incurred  by  them  for  such 
purposes,  and  of  the  several  purposes  for 
which  such  sums  of  money  are  paid  and 
such  liabilities  incurred. 

All  such  books  shall,  at  all  reasonable 
times,  be  open  to  the  examination  of  every 
onember  of  such  board,  churchwarden, 
•overseer,  and  ratepayer  without  fee  or 
reward,  and  they  respectively  may  take 
copies  of,  or  extracts  from  such  books,  or 
any  part  thereof,  without  paying  for  the 
same ;  and  in  case  the  members  of  such 
board,  or  any  of  them,  or  any  of  the 
officers  or  servants  of  such  board  having  the 
custody  of  the  said  books,  being  thereunto 
reasonably  requested,  refuse  to  permit  or  do 
not  permit  any  churchwarden,  overseer  or 
ratepayer  to  examine  the  same,  or  take  any 
such  copies  or  extracts,  every  such  mem- 
ber, officer,  or  servant  so  offending  shall 
for  every  such  offence,  upon  a  summary 
conviction  thereof  before  any  justice  of  the 
peace,  forfeit  any  sum  not  exceeding  five 
pounds. 

The  vestry  shall  yearly  appoint  two 
persons,  not  being  members  of  the  board, 
to  be  auditors  of  the  accounts  of  the 
l)oard,  and  at  such  time  in  the  month  of 
March  in  every  year  as  the  vestry  shall 
appoint,  the  board  shall  produce  to  the 
auditors  their  accounts,  with  sufficient 
vouchers  for  all  monies  received  and  paid, 
and  the  auditors  shall  examine  such 
accounts  and  vouchers,  and  report  thereon 
to  the  vestry. 

The  expenses  incurred,  or  to  be  incurred, 
by  the  lourial  board  of  any  parish  in 
carrying  this  Act  into  execution,  shall  be 
chargeable  upon  and  paid  out  of  the  rates 
for  the  relief  of  the  poor  of  such  parish; 
the  expenses  to  be  so  incurred  for  or  on 
account  of  any  parish  in  providing  and 
laying  out  a  burial  ground  under  this  Act, 
and  building  the  necessary  chapel  or  chapels 
thereon,  not  to  exceed  such  sum  as  the 
vestry  shall  authorize  to  be  expended  for 
such  purpose ;  and  the  oveersers  or  other 
officers  authorized  to  make  and  levy  rates 
for  the  relief  of  the  poor  in  any  parish 
shall,  upon  receipt  of  a  certificate  under 
the  hands  of  such  number  of  members  of 
the  burial  board  as  are  authorized  to 
exercise  the  powers  of  the  board,  of  the 
sums  required  from  time  to  time  for  defray- 
ing any  such  expenses  as  aforesaid,  pay  such 
sums  out  of  the  rates  for  the  relief  of  the 
poor,  as  the  board  shall  direct. 


VESTKY 


767 


Provided  always,  that  it  shall  be  lawful 
for  the  board,  with  the  sanction  of  the 
vestry  and  the  approval  of  the  commis- 
sioners of  her  Majesty's  treasury,  to  borrow 
any  money  required  for  providing  and 
laying  out  any  burial  ground  under  this 
Act,  and  building  a  chapel  or  chapels  there- 
on, or  any  of  such  purposes,  and  to 
charge  the  future  poor  rates  of  the  parish 
with  the  payment  of  such  money  and 
interest  thereon ;  provided  that  there  shall 
be  paid  iu  every  year,  in  addition  to  the 
interest  of  the  money  borrowed  and  un- 
paid, not  less  than  one-twentieth  of  the 
principal  sum  borrowed,  until  the  whole  is 
discharged. 

The  commissioners  for  carrying  into 
execution  an  Act  of  the  session  holden  in 
the  lith  and  15th  years  of  her  Majesty, 
0.  53,  "  to  authorize  for  a  further  pe- 
riod the  advance  of  money  out  of  the 
consolidated  fund  to  a  limited  amount  for 
carrying  on  public  works  and  fisheries  and 
employment  of  the  poor,"  and  any  Act  or 
Acts,  amending  or  continuing  the  same, 
may  from  time  to  time  make  to  the  burial 
board  of  any  parish  for  the  purposes  of  this 
Act  any  loan  under  the  provisions  of  the 
recited  Act,  or  the  several  Acts  therein 
recited  or  referred  to,  upon  security  of  the 
rates  for  the  relief  of  the  poor  of  the  parish. 

The  money  raised  for  defraying  such 
expenses,  and  the  income  arising  from  the 
burial  ground  provided  for  the  parish,  ex- 
cept fees  payable  to  the  incumbent,  clerk, 
and  sexton  of  the  parish,  and  the  other  fees 
herein  directed  to  be  otherwise  paid,  shall 
be  applied  by  the  board  in  or  towards 
defraying  the  expenses  of  such  board  under 
this  Act;  and  whenever,  after  repayment 
of  all  monies  borrowed  for  the  purposes  of 
this  Act  in  or  for  any  parish,  and  the  interest 
thereof,  and  after  satisfying  all  the  liabili- 
ties of  the  board  with  reference  to  the 
execution  of  this  Act  in  or  for  the  parish, 
and  providing  such  a  balance  as  shall  be 
deemed  by  the  board  sufficient  to  meet  their 
probable  liabUities  during  the  then  next 
year,  there  shall  be  at  the  time  of  holding 
the  meeting  of  the  vestry  at  which  the 
yearly  report  of  the  auditors  shall  be  pro- 
duced, any  surplus  money  at  the  disposal  of 
the  board,  they  shall  pay  the  same  to  the 
overseers,  in  aid  of  the  rate  for  the  relief  of 
the  poor  of  the  parish. 

The  vestries  of  any  parishes  which  shall 
have  respectively  resolved  to  provide  burial 
grounds  under  this  Act,  may  concur  in  pro- 
viding one  burial  ground  for  the  common 
use  of  such  parishes,  in  such  manner,  not 
inconsistent  ^vith  the  provisions  of  this  Act, 
as  they  shall  mutually  agree;  and  may 
agree  as  to  the  proportions  in  which  the 
expenses  of  such  burial  ground  shall   be 


7G8 


VESTEY 


bome  by  sucb  parisbes,  and  the  proportion 
for  each  of  such  parishes  of  such  expenses 
shall  be  chargeable  upon  and  paid  out  of  the 
monies  to  be  raised  for  the  relief  of  the  poor 
of  the  same  respective  parish  accordingly ; 
and,  according  and  subject  to  the  terms 
which  shall  have  been  so  agreed  on,  the 
burial  boards  appointed  for  such  parishes 
respectively  shall,  for  the  purpose  of  providing 
and  managing  such  one  burial  ground,  and 
taking  and  holding  land  for  the  same,  act 
as  one  joint  burial  board  for  all  such  parishes, 
and  may  have  a  joint  office,  clerk,  and 
officers,  and  aU  the  provisions  of  this  Act 
shall  apply  to  such  joint  burial  board  ac- 
cordingly ;  and  the  accounts  and  vouchers 
of  such  board  shall  be  examined  and  re- 
ported on  by  the  auditors  of  each  of  such 
parishes;  and  the  surplus  money  at  the 
disposal  as  aforesaid  of  such  board,  shall  be 
paid  to  the  overseers  of  such  parishes  re- 
spectively in  the  same  proportions  as  those  in 
■which  such  parishes  shall  be  liable  to  such 
expenses. 

For  the  more  easy  execution  of  the 
purposes  of  this  Act,  the  burial  board  of 
every  parish  appointed  under  this  Act  shall 
be  a  body  corporate,  by  the  name  of  "  The 

Burial  Board  for  the  Parish  of ,  in  the 

County  of  • ,"  and  by  that  name  shall 

have  perpetual  succession  and  a  common 
seal,  and  shall  sue  and  be  sued,  and  have 
power  and  authority  (without  any  licence 
in  mortmain)  to  take,  purchase,  and  hold 
land  for  the  purposes  of  this  Act ;  and  where 
the  burial  boards  of  two  or  more  parishes 
act  as,  and  form,  one  joint  bmial  board  for 
all  such  parishes  for  the  purposes  aforesaid, 
such  joiDt  board  shall  for  such  purposes  only 
be  a  body  corporate,  by  the  name  of  "  The 

Burial  Board  for  the   Parishes  of , 

and  ■ ,  in  the  County  of ,"  and  by 

that  name  shall  have  perpetual  succession, 
and  a  common  seal,  and  shall  sue  and  be 
sued,  and  have  power  and  authority  as 
aforesaid  to  take,  purchase,  and  hold  land 
for  the  purposes  of  this  Act. 

Every  burial  board  shall,  with  all  con- 
venient speed,  proceed  to  provide  a  burial 
ground  for  the  parish  or  parishes  for  which 
they  are  appointed  to  act,  and  to  make 
arrangements  for  facilitating  interments 
therein ;  and  in  providing  such  burial 
ground,  the  board  shall  have  reference  to 
the  convenience  of  access  thereto  from  the 
parish  or  parishes  for  which  the  same  is 
provided ;  and  any  such  burial  ground  may 
be  provided  either  within  or  vnthout  the 
limits  of  the  parish,  or  all  or  any  of  the 
parishes,  for  which  the  same  is  provided; 
but-  no  ground  not  already  used  as  or  ap- 
propriated for  a  cemetery,  shall  be  appro- 
priated as  a  burial  ground,  or  as  an  ad- 
dition to  a  burial  ground,  under  this  Act, 


VIATICUM 

nearer  than  200  yards  to  any  dwelling^ 
house,  without  the  consent  in  writing  of 
the  owner,  lessee,  and  occupier  of  such  dwell- 
ing house. 

For  the  providing  such  burial  ground,  it 
shall  be  lawful  for  the  burial  board,  with 
the  approval  of  the  vestry  or  vestries  of  the 
parish  or  respective  parishes,  to  contract  for 
and  purchase  any  lands  for  the  purpose  of 
forming  a  burial  ground,  or  for  making 
additions  to  any  burial  ground  to  be  formed 
or  purchased  under  this  Act,  as  such  board 
may  think  fit,  or  to  purchase  from  any 
company  or  persons  entitled  thereto  any 
cemetery  or  cemeteries,  or  part  or  parts 
thereof,  subject  to  the  rights  in  vaults  and 
graves,  and  other  subsisting  rights,  which 
may  have  been  previously  granted  therein : 
provided  always  that  it  shall  be  lawful  for 
such  board,  in  lieu  of  providing  any  such 
burial  ground,  to  contract  with  any  such 
company  or  persons  entitled  as  aforesaid  for 
the  interment  in  such  cemetery  or  cemeteries, 
and  either  in  any  allotted  part  of  such 
cemetery  or  cemeteries  or  othervrise,  and 
upon  such  terms  as  the  burial  board  may 
think  fit,  of  the  bodies  of  persons  who 
would  have  had  rights  of  interment  in  the 
burial  grounds  of  such  parish  or  respective 
parishes. 

VIATICUM  (from  via,  a  way  =  Greek 
trjyoSiov).  The  provision  made  for  a  journey. 
Hence,  in  the  ancient  Church,  both  baptism 
an  d  the  Eucharist  were  called  Viatica,  because 
they  were  equally  esteemed  men's  necessary 
provision  and  proper  armour,  both  to  sustain 
and  conduct  them  safe  on  their  way  in  their 
passage  through  this  world  to  eternal  life. 
The  administration  of  baptism  is  thus  spoken 
of  by  St.  Basil  and  Gregory  Nazianzen,  as 
the  giving  to  men  their  viaticum,  or  pro- 
vision for  their  journey  to  another  world 
(Basil,  Eom.  13,  de  Bapt. :  Naz.  Orat.  40, 
de  Bapt.) ;  and  under  this  impression  it  was 
frequently  delayed  till  the  hour  of  death, 
beiug  esteemed  as  a  final  security  and  safe- 
guard to  future  happiness.  But  this  delay 
was  always  esteemed  a  grievous  error,  as 
pointed  out  by  Gregory  Nazianzen  in  his 
work  on  Baptism  quoted  above,  and  other 
Fathers;  and  forbidden  by  councils  (e.g. 
Cone.  Elib.  can.  73,  &c.).  More  strictly, 
however,  the  term  viaticum  denoted  the 
Eucharist  given  to  persons  in  immediate 
danger  of  death.  In  this  sense  is  used  the 
term  to.  i^ohia  tov  Qeov  (Clem.  Ep.  1, 
ad  Cor.  c.  ii. :  Basil,  Ep.  Ivii.  ccxlix.  ad 
Melet. :  Cyril,  Horn.  Cat.  v.  sec.  12),  and 
€(p6Siov  Ca>rjs  alavlov,  which  occurs  in  the 
liturgies  of  St.  James,  St.  Basil,  and  St. 
Mark  (Hammond,  Liturg.  &c.  p.  191).  The 
13th  canon  of  the  Nicene  Coxmcil  ordains 
that  none  "  be  deprived  of  his  perfect  and 
most  necessary  viaticum,  when  he  departs 


VICAR 

out  of  this  life."  Several  other  canons  of 
various  councils  are  to  the  same  effect, 
providing  also  for  the  giving  of  the  viaticum 
under  peculiar  circumstances,  as  to  persons 
in  extreme  weakness,  delirium,  or  subject 
to  canonical  discipline  {C'arth.  iv.  cc.  76, 77  : 
Araus.  i.  c.  3  :  Arelat.  ii.  c.  28 :  Epaon.  c.  30  : 
Tolet.  xi.  c.  11,  &c.). 

Two  things  must  be  observed  from  these 
canons  in  the  case  of  the  viaticum  being 
taken  to  a  sick  ])erson :  (1)  the  penitential 
■discipline  was  not  observed  even  in  the  case 
of  evil  livers,  although  stipulation  was  made 
that  it  should  be  completed  in  case  of  re- 
covery ;  (2)  it  might  be  received  by  persons 
not    fasting    (See    Fasting    Communion). 
The  dying  person  was  evidently  in  early 
times    communicated    from    the    reserved 
sacrament,  and  the  viaticum  was  conveyed 
in  a  vessel   called   the  "  Chrismal,"     The 
priest  would  usually  take  it,  but  a  deacon 
(Justin  Martyr,  Apol.  i.  65),  or  even  a  lay- 
man (Euseb.  H.  E.  vi.  44),  might  be  com- 
missioned to  convey  it.    The  question  as  to 
whetiier  the  sacrament  was  administered  in 
one  kind  only  need  not  here  be  considered 
(see  Communion  in   One  Kind),  but  it  is 
probable  that  in  the  early  times  the  bread 
was  dipped  into  the  wine,  and  so  received 
(Bede,  H.  E.  iv.  14).     This  was  certainly 
the  case   in  the  Eastern   Chm-ch,   and  is 
implied  in  several  ancient  Western  service 
books.     "  Corpus  Domini  nostri  J.  Christ!, 
sanguine  suo  inlitum  intinctum,  mundet  te 
ab  omni  peccato  "  (Grerbertus,  Liturg.  Ale- 
man.  ii.  487).     With  regard  to  persons  in 
extremis,  and  hardly  able  to  swallow,  the 
liquiii  contents  of  the  chalice  were  allowed 
to    be    dropped     into    his    mouth    (Ccmc. 
Carthag.  iv.  c.  76;    Tolet.  xi.  c.  ll).     In 
the  Church  of  England  at  the  present  time 
private  celebrations  at  the  sick-bed  only  are 
allowed.     For  this,  see  Communion  of  Sick. 
— Bona,  Eer.  Lit.  i.  c.  xxi ;  Martene,  lib.  i. 
c.  vii. ;   Lingard,  Anglo-Saooon   Church,  ii. 
p.   44,  ed.   1858;    Maskell,   Mon.   Bit.  i. 
cclxxii.     [H.] 

VICAR.  Vicarius,  as  its  etymology 
denotes,  means  a  deputy ;  and  vicars  in 
■ecclesiology  are  deputies  of  various  kinds. 
Those  which  are  most  commonly  spoken 
■of  are  the  vicars  who  in  one  way  or  an- 
other represent  those  who  were  originally 
charged  with  the  parochial  cure  of  souls  and 
received  the  endowments  attached  thereto. 
The  history  of  their  institution  or  growth  is 
•obscure  and  complicated,  and  would  be  out 
■of  (place  here.  Many  pages  of  it  may  be 
read  in  Phillimore's  Eccl.  Law  and  other 
books.  It  is  enough  to  say  that  when  a 
spiritual  rector  or  parson,  persona  ecclesix, 
had  been  endowed  with  the  great  tithes  of 
a  parish  he  was  chargeable  with  the  cure  of 
«ouls  himself.     When  the  endowments  had 


VICARS  CHORAL 


7G9 


somehow  got  into  the  hands  of  an  ecclesi- 
astical corporation,  or  a  monastery,  they  had 
to  provide  what  may  be  called  a  curate  in  a 
popular  sense ;  and  an  Act  as  early  as  15 
Ric.  II.  c.  6,  enacted  that  "on  every  appro- 
priation (i.e.  endowment  of  any  such  body, 
or  of  a  lay  rector,  with  the  tithes)  .  .  .  the 
vicar  should  be  well  and  sufficiently  en- 
dowed." And  by  4  Hen.  IV.  c.  12,  "  in  everj 
church  appropriated  there  shall  be  a  secular 
(i.e.  a  non-monkish)  person  ordained  vicar 
perpetual,  canonically  instituted  and  in- 
ducted, and  covenaljly  endowed  by  the 
discretion  of  the  ordinary  to  do  divine 
service  and  to  inform  the  people,  and  to 
keep  hospitality  there ;  and  no  religious  (i.e. 
no  monk)  shall  in  any  wise  be  made  vicar 
in  any  church  appropriated." 

Those  well-intended  laws  were  however 
baffled  and  evaded  by  the  monasteries,  both 
by  making  very  inadequate  endowments, 
and  otherwise,  like  all  other  attempts  to 
regulate  them;  and  thence  it  was  that  the 
scandalous  anomaly  exists  of  laymen,  the 
grantees  of  the  spoils  of  the  monasteries, 
receiving  the  greatest  part  of  the  tithes  of 
many  parishes  which  were  granted  originally 
for  the  maintenance  of  the  church,  the  clergy 
and  the  poor.  (The  subject  of  rectors  or 
parsons  belongs  to  other  articles :  q.v.) 

Generally,  but  not  invariably,  the  vicars 
were  endowed  under  the  above-mentioned 
Acts  with  what  are  called  "small  tithes," 
the  rectors  having  the  "  great "  ones,  which 
are  usually  of  corn,  hay  and  wood  and  fruit; 
but  potatoes  have  been  decided  to  be 
"  small,"  in  whatever  quantity  they  may 
be  grown.  But  all  this  has  been  superseded 
and  made  immaterial  by  the  Tithe  Com- 
mutation Acts  (See  Tithes).  Moreover,  the 
word  vicar  has  acquired  a  much  wider 
meaning  by  two  recent  Acts.  By  the  Dis- 
trict Churches  Tithes  Act,  1865,  s.  9,  in- 
cumbents of  new  parishes  as  soon  as  they 
were  endowed  with  any  payment  out  of  the 
great  or  small  tithes  arising  therein  could 
be  declared  by  the  Ecclesiastical  Commis- 
sioners rectors  and  vicars  accordingly,  instead 
of  being  "  perpetual  curates,"  as  they  were 
before.  This  was  found  anomalous  and 
misleading,  and  so  that  section  was  repealed 
by  31  &  32  Vict.  c.  117,  which  absolutely 
makes  the  incumbents  of  all  new  parishes 
thereafter  vicars,  as  soon  as  they  become 
entitled  to  perform  marriages  and  to  keep 
the  fees.  Consequently  perpetual  curates 
have  all  but  ceased  to  exist  and  will  become 
extinct,  except  for  the  short  interval  during 
which  the  incumbent  of  the  old  parish  re- 
mains entitled  to  the  marriage  fees.  Per- 
petual curacies  had  long  been  declared  to 
be  benefices  (See  Curates,  and  Pews).  [C] 
VICARS  CHORAL.  The  assistants  or 
deputies  of  the  canons  or  prebendaries  of 

3  D 


770 


VIOAES  CHOEAL 


collegiate  churclies,  in  the  discharge  of 
their  duties,  especially,  though  not  ex- 
clusively, those  performed  in  the  choir  or 
chancel,  as  distinguished  from  those  be- 
longing to  the  altar  and  pulpit. 

The  vicars  choral,  as  their  name  implies, 
were  originally  appointed  as  the  deputies 
of  the  canons  and  prebendaries  for  Church 
purposes ;  that  is,  to  provide  for  the  absence 
or  incapacity  of  the  great  body  of  capitular 
members :  the  clerical  vicars  to  chant  in 
rotation  the  prayers  at  matins  and  evensong, 
&c.,  and  the  whole  body  to  form  a  sufiScient 
and  permanent  choir  for  the  performance  of 
the  daily  service ;  a  duty  which  the  canons 
were  originally  required  to  perform  in 
person.  The  presbyteral  members  were 
usually  four,  being  the  vicars  of  the  four 
dignitaries,  persons  principales  (See  Per- 
scna).  Sometimes  they  were  five;  the 
rest  were  deacons,  and  in  minor  orders,  in 
later  times,  chiefly  laymen. 

This  institution  was  most  salutary  ;  since, 
were  every  canon  required  to  have  the  pe- 
culiar qualifications  required  from  vicars, 
viz.  a  practical  knowledge  of  ecclesiastical 
music,  men  of  higher  and  more  important 
qualities  would  of  necessity  be  often  ex- 
cluded from  the  canonical  stalls.  In  fact, 
the  appointment  of  deacons  and  inferior 
miuisfiers  to  this  peculiar  oiEce,  which  we 
do  not  find  established  till  the  beginning  of 
the  fourth  century  (i.e.  the  KavoviKoX  ^j^akTai, 
Bingham,  iii.  7),  bears  a  striking  analogy  to 
the  regulation  of  the  Jewish  temple,  where 
some  of  the  Levites,  the  deacons  of  the 
elder  Church,  were  newly  appointed  by 
David  to  the  musical  service.  Originally 
the  vicars  choral  were  commensurate  with 
the  capitular  members,  each  of  these  having 
a  vicar,  appointed  by  himself,  and  holding 
his  place  only  so  long  as  his  principal  lived. 
The  numbers  have  now  greatly  diminished. 
At  York  they  were  at  one  time  36 ;  at 
Salisbury,  25 ;  at  Hereford,  20. 

In  all  cathedrals  of  the  old  foundation  in 
England,  where  there  were  choirs,  the  vicars 
choral  formed  a  minor  corporation,  in  some 
way  under  the  control  of  the  dean  or 
chapter,  but  with  separate  estates,  with 
collegiate  buildings,  halls,  and  chapels,  some 
of  which  still  subsist.  Those  at  Chichester 
and  Wells  were  incorporated  in  the  14th 
century,  those  at  Hereford  and  Exeter  in  the 
15th.  At  Southwell  they  formerly  consti- 
tuted a  college,  till  the  Eeformation.  Their 
presidents  were  styled  custos,  or  warden, 
sub-dean,  sub-chanter,  provost,  or  pro- 
cmator. 

In  cathedrals  of  the  new  foundation,  the 
name  Vicar  Choral  was  generally  superseded 
by  that  of  Minor  Canon  for  the  clergy,  and 
Lay-clerk  for  the  laity  (See  Minor  Canon). 
— Jebb,  Choral  Service. 


VICAE  PENSIONAEY 

III.  VICAR  GENEEAL  of  a  bishop  is 
his  chancellor  (q.v.).  The  vicars  general 
of  the  two  archbishops  have  some  provincial 
functions  also,  and  generally  act  for  them 
in  confirming  bishops  of  the  province,  but 
must  be  distinguished  from  the  Provincial 
Judge  or  Dean  of  Arches  and  Judge  of  the 
Chancery  Court  of  York  (who  oddly  enough 
is  not  the  Chancellor).  Neither  is  a  com- 
missary, who  is  appointed  by  a  bishop  or 
archbishop  for  a  particular  purpose  or  time, 
the  same  as  his  vicar  general,  who  has  a 
judicial  office.  The  vicar  general  of  Canter- 
bury usually  institutes  incumbents,  and  pro- 
rogues convocation.  But  that  is  not  the 
use  of  York.  Under  the  Statute  of  Supre- 
macy, 26  Hen.  VIII.  c.  1,  which  was  repealed 
by  Maiy  and  not  revived  by  Elizabeth  but 
another  Act  substituted  for  it,  Thomas- 
Cromwell  was  appointed  "the  king's  vicar 
general,  vicegerent  and  principal  com- 
missary." Not  that  the  Act  expressly 
instituted  such  an  office,  but  it  gave  the 
king  power  to  visit,  repress,  &c.,  all  heresies 
which  by  any  manner  of  spiritual  au- 
thority or  jurisdiction  might  lawfully  be 
repressed,  corrected,  &c.,  and  declared  him 
"  the  only  supreme  head  in  earth  of  the 
Church  of  England."  That  title  was  altered 
by  1  Eliz.  c.  1,  into  "  supreme  governor  in 
all  spiritual  or  ecclesiastical  things  or 
causes  as  well  as  in  temporal ; "  which  the. 
Report  of  the  Commission  on  Ecclesiastical 
Courts,  1883,  very  oddly  omits,  while  it  states- 
(on  what  authority  it  also  omits  to  say)  that 
the  more  indefinite  "title  of  supreme  head 
was  never  accepted  as  part  of  the  Reformation 
settlement."  It  certainly  was  accepted  and 
acted  on  in  the  most  practical  way  for  twenty- 
five  years,  until  the  Act  was  first  repealed  by 
the  Papists  and  then  amended  as  above,  and 
the  Court  of  High  Commission  substituted 
for  the  royal  vicar  general,  until  that  also  was 
abolished  by  the  Long  Parliament,  and  again 
declared  illegal  by  1  W.  &  M.  c.  1.     [G.] 

VICARS'  COLLEGE.  The  residence  of 
the  non-capitular  members  of  a  cathedral. 
At  Wells,  the  court  remains,  entered  by 
a  gatehouse  and  lined  with  the  houses- 
of  the  vicars,  with  hall,  library,  and 
chapel ;  at  Hereford  the  college  forms  a, 
beautiful  cloistered  quadrangle,  with  the 
same  adjuncts :  at  Chichester  and  Exeter 
the  halls  only,  which  are  of  the  fourteenth 
century,  have  been  preserved :  and  at  Lin- 
coln considerable  portions,  of  the  ancient 
buildings  remain.  Until  the  civil  war  the 
collegiate  life  was  everywhere  maintained — 
at  Hereford  so  lately  as  1828. — Walcott's 
Sac.  Arch.  603.     [H.] 

VICAR.  PENSIONARY.  Certain  cler- 
gymen appointed  at  a  fixed  stipend  to  serve 
churches,  the  titles  of  which  belonged  to  a 
collegiate  foundation:   as  at  St.  Salvador's- 


VICE-DEAN 

College,  St.  Andrews)  See  Lyons'  History 
of  St.  Andrews). 

VICE-DEAN,  or  SUBDEAN.  In  ca- 
thedrals of  the  new  foundation,  one  of  the 
canons  is  annually  chosen  to  represent  the 
dean  in  his  absence ;  and  as  such  he  ranks 
next  to  him  in  the  choir  and  chapter.  In 
most  of  the  old  ones  it  is  a  permanent  office. 
At  York  it  is  singular  that  the  subdean  is 
not  even  a  canon  ex  officio,  nor  in  fact  at 
present.    [G.] 

VIDAMB :  Vicedominus.  The  Ticege- 
rent,  or  official  of  a  bishop  in  temporals. 
A  dignitary  in  a  few  foreign  cathedrals  is 
thus  called  :  a  sort  of  subdean. 

VIGrIL  (Lat.  vigilare,  to  watch).  The 
night  or  evening  before  certain  holy-days  of 
the  Church.  In  former  times  it  was  cus- 
tomary to  have  religious  services  on  these 
eves,  and  sometimes  to  spend  a  great  part 
of  the  night  in  prayer  and  other  devotions, 
to  qualify  the  soul  for  the  better  observance 
of  the  festival  itself  on  the  morrow.  These 
nights  thus  spent  were  called  vigils  or 
watchings,  and  are  still  professedly  observed 
in  the  Church  of  England. 

This  term  originated  in  a  custom  of  the 
early  Christians,  who  fasted  and  watched 
the  whole  night  previous  to  any  great  fes- 
tival; hence  Vigilim,  Vigils,  or  watchings. 
As  a  military  custom  this  was  most  an- 
cient. The  Jews  seem  originally  to  have 
divided  the  night  into  three  watches ;  but 
in  the  New  Testament  we  read  of  "  the 
fourth  watch  of  the  night"  (St.  Mark  vi. 
48),  a  custom,  perhaps,  introduced  by  their 
conquerors,  the  Romans,  who  divided  their 
night  into  four  vigils.  The  primitive 
Christians  might  have  been  inclined  to 
this  custom  from  various  references  to  it  in 
the  Gospel ;  particularly  in  the  close  of  the 
parable  of  the  ten  virgins  ;  though  it  is  not 
improbable  that  the  secrecy  with  which  they 
■were  obliged  to  meet,  "  for  fear  of  the  Jews  " 
(St.  John  XX.  19),  and  other  persecutors, 
went  far  towards  establishing  it.  The  cus- 
tom became  general,  and  St.  Jerome,  who 
had  to  defend  it  against  Vigilantius,  brings 
forward  abundant  Scriptural  authority  {Ep. 
xxxvi.,  de  Observ.  Vigil.).  But  this,  like 
many  other  innocent  or  necessary  cere- 
monies, having  been  at  length  abused,  the 
nocturnal  vigils  were  abolished,  about  the 
year  420,  and  turned  into  evening  fasts, 
preparatory  to  the  principal  festival  (Duran- 
dus,  vi.  7).  But  it  appears  that  a  vigil  was 
observed  on  All  HaUows  Day,  by  watching 
and  ringing  of  bells  all  night  long,  even  till 
the  year  1545,  when  Henry  VIII.,  in  his 
letter  to  Cranmer,  as  to  "creeping  to  the 
cross,''  &c.,  desired  it  might  be  abolished. 

Every  festival  has  not  a  vigil  preceding  it. 
Those  appointed  by  the  Church  are  as 
foUows : — 


VIRGIN  MARY 


771 


Before  the  Nativity  of  our  Lord.  The 
Purification  and  Annunciation  of  the  Blessed 
Virgin.  Easter  Day.  Ascension  Day.  Pen- 
tecost. St.  Matthias.  St.  John  Baptist. 
St.  Peter.  St.  James.  St.  Bartholomew. 
St.  Matthew.  St.  Simon  and  St.  Jude.  St. 
Thomas.     St.  Andrew.     All  Saints. 

It  has  been  given  as  a  reason  why  the 
other  holy-days  have  no  vigils  before  them, 
that  they  generally  happened  between 
Christmas  and  the  Purification,  or  between 
Easter  and  Whitsuntide,  seasons  of  joy 
which  the  Church  did  not  think  fit  to  break 
into  by  fasting  and  humiliation.  See  fully 
on  this  subject,  Wheatly  on  the  Common 
Prayer. 

VIRGIN  MARY  (See  Mariolatry  and 
Motlier  of  Ood).  The  mother  of  our  Blessed 
Lord  and.  Saviour  Jesus  Christ.  "  She  was 
of  all  the  women,  of  all  the  virgins  in  Israel, 
elected  and  chosen  by  God  to  be  the 
instrument  of  bringing  into  the  world  the 
long-desired  Messias.  All  the  virtuous 
daughters  of  Jacob,  a  good  while  before  the 
revelation  of  our  Saviour,  but  especially  in 
the  age  when  He  appeared  (the  time  wherein 
they  saw  the  more  punctual  and  remarkable 
prophecies  concerning  the  coming  of  the 
Messias  fulfilled),  desired,  and  were  not 
without  hopes,  each  of  them,  that  they 
might  have  had  this  honour  done  unto 
them.  But  it  was  granted  to  none  of  all 
these  holy  women  and  virgins,  but  to  the 
Virgin  Mary.  And  therefore  'all  genera- 
tions shall  call  her  blessed.' " — Bishop  Bull's 
Sermons. 

Although  always  the  greatest  veneration 
was  given  to  the  Blessed  Virgin,  yet  no 
instance  of  Divine  honour  paid  her  is 
recorded  of  an  earlier  date  than  the  fifth 
century.  Cyril  'of  Alexandria  and  Proklus 
of  Constantinople  were  the  first  to  pay 
these  honours  to  her.  Festivals  to  her 
memory  began  to  be  held  about  the  year 
431,  but  were  not  generally  observed  until 
the  sixth  century.  From  this  time  until 
the  sixteenth  century,  they  were  general  in 
all  the  Western  Churches,  though  differing 
in  mmaber  and  in  rank,  in  the  several 
countries  of  Europe.  The  Greek  Church 
observes  only  three  great  festivals  of  this 
description. 

The  English  Calendar  contains  two  classes 
of  these  festivals:  I.  The  Red-letter  Fes- 
tivals. 1.  The  Purification.  Candlemas, 
Feb.  2,  instituted  in  the  sixth  century.  2. 
The  Annunciation,  popularly  styled  Lady 
Day,  March  25th,  an  early  festival,  styled 
by  St.  Bernard,  radix  omnium  festorum. 
II.  The  Black-letter  (or  lesser)  Festivals. 
1.  The  Visitation  of  Mary  to  Elizabeth, 
instituted  by  Urban  VL,  1389.  2.  The 
Nativity  of  Mary,  Sept.  8th,  instituted  in 
the  Eastern  Church  in  the  seventh  century ; 

3  D  2 


£■72 


VISITATION 


in  the  Western,  in  the  eleventh  or  twell'ih. 
3.  The  Conception.  This  feast,  according  to 
Bellarmine,  was  not  necessarily  dependent 
upon  the  question  so  fiercely  discussed  in 
the  twelfth  and  thirteenth  centuries  respect- 
ing the  immaculate  conception  (See  Con- 
ception). The  Assumption  of  Mary  into 
Heaven,  Aug.  15th,  early  instituted.  Mary 
was  the  tutelary  divinity  of  France ;  and 
for  this  reason  this  day  was  obsei-ved  with 
peculiar  care.  It  was  also  the  birthday  of 
Napoleon,  and  accordingly  was  observed 
under  his  dynasty  as  the  great  festival  of  the 
nation. 

These  occur  in  all  the  Calendars  (Eastern 
Orthodox,  Armenian,  Ethiopic,  Roman  and 
Anglican),  but  there  are  many  other  festivals 
to  the  Virgin  Mary,  which  are  observed  in 
one  or  other  of  the  Calendars.  The  Pre- 
sentation (not  of  our  Lord,  but  of  Mary  ac- 
cording to  a  legend)  and  the  Assumption,  or 
taking  of  St.  Mary  into  Heaven  in  body  and 
soul,  are  observed  both  in  the  Greek  and 
Latin  Churches.  The  others  are  more  local 
and  fanciful  (See  Diet.  Christ.  Ant.).     [H.] 

VISITATION.  Ecclesiastical  visita- 
tions by  bishops  and  archdeacons  under  the 
general  law  are  of  a  different  kind  from 
those  by  the  visitors  of  colleges  and  other 
such  corporations  under  their  special  statutes. 
The  latter  class  of  visitors  are  more  judicial 
than  the  former,  and  seldom — -we  may  now 
say,  never — act  except  when  appealed  to  by 
some  members  of  the  college  against  others 
under  the  statutes,  and  there  is  no  appeal 
from  them  so  long  as  they  keep  within  their 
jurisdiction.  Nor  indeed  is  there  an  appeal 
then  in  the  legal  sense.  Their  judgments 
then  either  go  for  nothing,  or  if  necessary, 
they  may  be  restrained.  College  visitors 
may  be  anybody,  either  o6Bcial  or  some 
heirs  of  a  founder,  and  in  a  few  cases  the 
colleges  have  power  to  elect  their  own  visitor. 
"VVe  are  only  concerned  here  with  strictly 
ecclesiastical  visitation.  In  ancient  times 
bishops  appear  to  have  had  much  more  visita- 
torial power  and  to  have  exercised  it  much 
oftener  than  they  have  for  some  centuries. 
It  is  only  necessary  to  consider  what  power 
they  and  their  archdeacons  have  now. 
Their  punitive  powers  over  the  clergy  were 
materially  reduced  by  the  Clergy  Discipline 
Act  of  1840,  as  was  decided  in  the  famous 
Dean  of  York's  case,  which  arose  under  a 
visitation  held  that  very  year  by  (the  first) 
Dr.  PhiUimore  as  commissary  for  the  arch- 
bishop. He,  and  then  the  archbishop,  form- 
ally "deprived"  Dean  Cockburn  both  for 
simony  in  selling  his  oflScial  patronage  and  for 
contumacy  in  refusing  to  answer  the  charge ; 
for  both  of  which  he  expressed  his  regret  at 
a  later  stage  of  the  visitation,  after  the 
decision  of  the  Queen's  Bench,  that  the 
deprivation  was  ultra  vires  of  the  visitor, 


VISITATION 

since  that  Act,  whether  it  would  have  been 
so  before  or  not,  which  was  left  undecided. 
But  the  Court  held  that  all  the  proceedings 
up  to  that  point  were  legal,  i.e.  so  far  as  they 
were  of  the  nature  of  an  inquiry,  on  which 
the  archbishop  might  then  have  taken  pro- 
ceedings in  the  provincial  Court  under  the 
Act.  The  judgment  is  given  in  full  in 
Phillimore's  Ecc.  Law,  1335. 

It  seems  to  have  been  the  old  rule  or 
practice  that  bishops  visited  their  cathedrals 
first,  and  then  their  parish  churches,  or  rather 
the  clergy  of  them,  every  three  years.  But 
cathedral  visitations  have  long  been  very 
rare  occurrences  and  seldom  made  except 
for  some  special  reason.  The  bishop  then 
issues  a  series  of  questions,  as  in  the  York 
case,  which  are  answered  in  writing  first,  and 
then  he  holds  a  personal  inquiry,  if  he  thinks 
fit.  Lord  Penzance's  Report  on  ecclesiastical 
courts  in  1883  states  that  no  particular 
formality  is  required  (See  Ecclesiastical 
Courts).  The  diocesan  visitations  are  a 
different  thing.  In  some  dioceses,  e.g. 
London,  they  are  held  only  every  fourth 
year,  but  generally  every  third.  When  the 
bishop  visits,  all  the  archdeacons'  jurisdic- 
tion is  suspended  or  "  inhibited  "  for  the  time. 
He  issues  questions  to  the  clergy,  and 
summons  them  to  meet  him  at  a  few  of  the 
principal  churches  in  the  diocese,  and  by 
custom  delivers  a  "  charge."  Meanwhile  his 
chancellor,  by  himself  or  one  or  more  surro- 
gates, visits  at  the  same  churches  where  the 
archdeacons  generally  do,  for  the  purpose  of 
admitting  churchwardens,  and  sometimes 
also  they  deliver  charges  by  way  of  informa- 
tion to  the  churchwardens. 

Canons  113, 115,  116, 117,  118, 119, 121, 
137,  contain  many  directions  about  archi- 
diaconal  visitations,  but  they  are  mostly 
obsolete,  if  they  ever  were  observed,  and  it 
is  unnecessary  to  copy  them  here.  The 
archdeacons  visit  every  year  except  when 
the  bishop  does,  and  they  summon  the 
clergy  and  deliver  charges  as  he  does,  besides 
admitting  the  newly  elected  or  continuing 
churchwardens  (See  Churchwardens).  This 
is  independent  of  the  archdeacons'  general 
duty  to  visit  the  churches  when  they  think 
fit,  to  see  that  they  are  in  good  repair  (See 
Visitor,  and  Archdeacon).     [C] 

VISITATION  OP  THE  SICK.  L  In 
all  ages  of  the  Church  her  presbyters  have 
been  expected  to  visit  the  sick,  to  pray  with 
them,  to  pronounce  absolution,  and  to  ad- 
minister the  sacraments  and  extreme  unc- 
tion. "Is  any  sick  among  you,"  writes 
St.  James,  "  let  him  send  for  the  elders 
(tou£  ■KpefT^vripovs)  of  the  Church,  and 
let  them  pray  over  him,  anointing  him 
with  oil  in  the  name  of  the  Lord :  and  the 
prayer  of  faith  shall  save  the  sick,  and 
the  Lord  shall  raise  him  up,  and  if  he  have 


VISITATION 

committed  sins  they  shall  be  forgiven  him '' 
(v.  14).  Part  of  this  office  might  be  per- 
formed by  deacons  or  laymen,  and  in  times 
of  epidemic  or  infectious  disease,  certain 
officers  called  parabolani  were  appointed  for 
this  very  pvirpose  (Bingham,  ix.  9,  3).  The 
sacrament  also  could  be  conveyed  by  a 
messenger.  But  the  pronouncing  the  abso- 
lution, and  the  administration  of  the  unc- 
tion required  the  presence  of  a  priest. 
Hence,  St.  Polycarp,  the  disciple  of  St. 
John,  in  his  epistle  to  the  Ephesians, 
especially  enjoins  the  presbyters  to  look 
after  the  sick  (iiruTKiwrfirBai  tovs  curBcveis), 
and  in  many  councils  similar  directions  are 
given  (e.g.  Uonc.  Nic.  c.  13;  Cone.  Carthag. 
iv.  cc.  76,  77 ;  Cone.  Araus.  i.  c.  3). 

In  England  many  provincial  constitutions 
required  all  rectors  and  vicars  of  parishes 
"  to  be  diligent  in  their  visitations  of  those 
that  are  sick"  (Lyndwood,  Prov.  Const,  i. 
2 ;  Wilkins'  Cone.  tom.  i.  p.  103 ;  Thorpe, 
2,  100).  It  is  to  be  observed  that  it  is  gener- 
ally implied  that  the  priests  should  be  sent 
for,  or  informed  of  the  sickness;  "Notice 
shall  be  given  to  the  Minister  of  the  Parish  " 
(Rubric) ;  and  in  the  Ordination  of  Deacons 
it  is  stated  to  be  part  of  their  duty  to  search 
out  the  sick  in  the  parish  in  which  they 
are  appointed  to  minister,  and  to  give  notice 
of  such  cases  to  the  incumbent.  In  many 
jDlaces  now  this  important  work  is  done  by 
district  visitors  and  lay  helpers  (See  Lay 
Helpers). 

Canon  67  directs  "  When  any  person  is 
dangerously  sick  in  any  parish,  the  minister 
or  curate  (having  knowledge  thereof)  shall 
resort  unto  him  or  her  (if  the  disease  be 
not  known  or  probably  suspected  to  be 
infectious)  to  instruct  and  comfort  them  in 
their  distress  according  to  the  order  of  the 
Communion  Book  if  he  be  no  preacher,  or 
if  he  be  a  preacher,  then  as  he  shall  think 
most  needful  and  convenient." 

IL  The  order  for  the  Visitation  of  the 
Sick  in  the  Prayer  Book  is  a  formulary 
which  has  been  used  with  slight  alteration 
in  our  churches  from  earliest  times.  Nearly 
all  the  rubrics  and  prayers  are  to  be  found 
in  the  ancient  Manuals  of  the  Church  of 
England,  and  some  of  the  prayers  can  be 
traced  almost  to  primitive  times.  Two 
portions  of  the  old  rite  have  been  omitted 
in  our  Prayer  Book,  the  use  of  extreme 
unction  (for  the  reason  of  which  see  Com- 
munion of  the  Sick,  Extreme  Unetion),  and 
the  procession  of  the  priest  and  his  clerks ; 
"  In  primis  induat  se  sacerdos  super  pellicio 
cum  stola,  et  in  eundo  dicat  cum  suis 
ministris  septem  psalmos  pcenitentiales  cum 
Gloria  Patri"  (Pontificale  Sarum).  The 
structure  of  the  office  shows  that  it  is  not 
intended  to  be  used  in  the  ordinary  visits  of 
the  clergyman  to  his  sick  parishioner.     The 


VISITOE 


773 


Exhortation  and  Confession  and  the  form. 
of  Absolution,  more  solemn  and  direct  than 
in  any  other  office  (see  Absolution),  evi- 
dently imply  that  it  is  to  be  used  once,  and 
not  as  the  customary  prayers  of  the  cler<'y. 
The  duties  of  the  clergy  in  visiting  the 
sick  therefore  resolve  themselves  into  two 
distinct  branches — the  ordinary  pastoral 
instruction,  consolation,  and  prayer,  and 
the  use  of  the  two  services  of  Visitation 
and  Communion.  The  office  contains,  1. 
Supplications  to  aveit  evil,  in  the  salu- 
tation and  short  litany.  2.  Prayers  to 
procure  good  things,  in  the  Lord's  Prayer 
and  the  two  collects.  3.  Exhortations 
prescribed  in  the  large  form  of  exhortation ; 
and  directions  in  the  rubric,  to  advise  the 
sick  man  to  forgive  freely,  to  give  liberally, 
to  do  justice  in  settling  his  estate,  and  to 
confess  his  sins  humbly  and  ingenuously 
unto  God's  minister  now  with  him.  4. 
Consolations;  in  the  absolution,  and  the 
prayer  to  God  to  confirm  it;  in  the  71st 
Psalm,  and  the  concluding  benedictions. 

The  four  prayers  for  particular  purjxises 
for  a  sick  child,  for  one  past  recovery,  for 
a  dying  person,  and  for  one  troubled  in 
conscience,  at  the  end  of  the  office,  were 
added  at  the  revision  in  1661. — Martene, 
de  Ant.  Keel.  Hit.  iii.  c.  11;  Maskell,  Mon. 
Bit.  i.  80 ;  Palmer,  Orig.  Idturg.  ii.  220 ; 
Blunt's  Annot.  P.  B.  iu  275 ;  P.  B.  inter- 
leaved, 200.     [H.] 

VISITOR.  The  distinctions  between  the 
diS'erent  kinds  of  visitatorial  power  have 
been  noticed  already  under  Visitation.  As 
a  general  rule,  all  corporations,  aggregate 
or  sole,  not  purely  civil,  are  visitable  by 
somebody,  and  both  the  corporations  as  a 
whole  and  the  members  thereof.  In  one 
very  famous  case,  that  of  Trinity  College, 
Cambridge,  under  its  old  Elizabethan 
statutes,  which  worked  for  as  many  cen- 
turies as  they  now  do  for  years  without 
alteration,  the  Master  had  a  different  visitor 
from  the  College,  possibly  because  the 
Crown,  which  was  general  visitor  through 
the  Lord  Chancellor,  had  the  appointment 
of  the  Master,  who  was  therefore  made 
visitable  and  deprivable  by  the  bishop  of 
Ely.  It  must  be  remembered  that  the 
Clergy  Discipline  Act,  1840,  only  affected 
the  trial  of  clergymen,  and  all  the  old 
visitatorial  power  remained  over  the  lay 
members  and  officers  of  cathedral  chapters, 
as  was  determined  in  B.  v.  Dean  of  Chester 
(15  Ad.  &  BU.  N.S.  513,  and  Phill.  E.  L. 
1343),  where  it  was  held  that  under  the 
cathedral  statutes  a  deprived  chorister  or 
vicar  choral  could  only  appeal  to  the  bishop 
as  visitor,  and  not  to  the  courts  of  law,  either 
ecclesiastical  or  civil.  But  in  the  Exeter  Rere- 
dos  case  (Phillpotts  v.  Boyd,  6  P.  C.  435), 
an  appeal  was  heard  from  the  bishop  as 


774 


VOLUNTARY 


ordinary  visitor  of  tlie  cathedral  to  the 
Dean  of  Arches  and  the  Privy  Council,  and 
the  visitor's  (assessor's)  judgment  reversed, 
and  also  Sir  R.  PhiUimore's,  that  the  bishop 
had  no  such  jurisdiction  as  visitor,  though  it 
affirmed  that  he  has  no  preliminary  discre- 
tion, as  he  or  his  chancellor  has,  to  refuse 
a  faculty,  there  being  no  precedent  of  a 
faculty  to  a  chapter.    [G.] 

VOLUNTAEY.  A  piece  of  music  played 
on  the  organ,  usually  after  the  Psalms, 
sometimes  after  the  second  lesson,  so  called 
because  the  choice  of  the  music  is  left  to 
the  will  (voluntas)  of  the  organist,  and  is 
mentioned  by  Archbishop  Seeker  as  having 
long  been  customary  in  his  day.  At  Dur- 
ham a  voluntary  has  been  substituted  for 
the  "Agnus  Dei"  which  was  once  sung 
during  the  communion  of  the  laity.  The 
term  is  now  generally  appUed  to  the  pieces 
of  music  played  by  the  organist  at  the  be- 
girming  and  end  of  the  service.  Lord 
Bacon  approves  of  voluntaries  as  affording 
time  for  meditation. 

A'^OWS,  BAPTISMAL.  (1)  Of  renun- 
ciation. This  is  referred  to  by  TertuUian 
{Be  Coron.  iii.) ;  St.  Basil  refers  to  it  as 
one  of  the  unwritten  traditions  and  customs 
of  the  Church ;  and  St.  Cyril  gives  the  form 
as  "I  renounce  thee  Satan,  and  all  thy 
works,  and  all  thy  pomp,  and  all  thy  ser- 
vice." The  English  form  originally  con- 
tained three  renunciations,  as  is  the  case  in 
the  form  in  the  Eastern  Church  (Neale's 
Sist.  East.  Church,  ii.  945).  These  were 
combined  in  1552. 

(2)  The  vow  of  belief.  This  is  of  Scriptural 
origin  (Acts  viii.  37,  &c.),  and  a  confession 
of  belief  is  spoken  of  in  most  of  the  Fathers 
as  necessary  before  baptism.  The  Creed, 
though  not  yet  written  down,  was  required 
to  be  said  by  each  catechumen  in  the 
early  times  (St.  Cyp.  Ep.  70,  76  (See 
Creed). 

(3).  The  vow  of  obedience.  This  does 
not  appear  in  the  ancient  sacramentaries, 
and  seems  to  have  been  inserted  in  our 
Prayer  Book  by  Bishop  Cosin's  advice. 
Yet  in  very  ancient  times  a  similar  declara- 
tion had  to  be  made  in  the  Eastern  Church  ; 
Justin  Martyr  speaks  of  such  a  vow  ;  and 
the  Apostolic  Constitutions  appoint  a  "  pro- 
mise of  obedience." — Just.  Mart.  Apol.  i. ; 
Apost.  Consiit.  vii.  c.  42 ;  Martene,  Ant. 
Ecd.  i.  180 ;  Bingham,  ii  7, 6 ;  Annvt.  P.  B. 
ii.  222.    [H.] 

VULGAR  TONGUE.  The  tongue  com- 
monly spoken  by  the  natives  in  any  place 
(from  Lat.  vulgus,  "  the  common  people  "). 
This  expression  in  the  baptismal  oiKce  stood 
formerly  "  in  the  English  tongue."  The  alter- 
ation was  made  in  compliance,  as  it  should 
seem,  with  a  suggestion  of  Bishop  Cosin,  that 
"  suppose,  as  it  often  falls  out,  that  children 


VULGATE 

of  strangers,  which  never  intend  to  stay  in 
England,  be  brought  there  to  be  baptized," 
it  would  be  exceptionable  that  "  they  also 
should  be  exhorted  and  enjoined  to  learn 
those  principles  of  religion  in  the  English 
tongue." 

VULGATE  (VULGATAEDITIO,  Koivif 
exSoo-ir).  The  name  originally  of  any  cur- 
rent popular  version  of  the  Bible.  In  this 
sense  it  was  frequently  applied  to  the  Sep- 
tuagint.  But  the  Vulgate  has  long  since 
become  the  special  name  of  the  Latin  revised 
version  which  was  produced  by  Jerome  early 
in  the  fifth  century.  The  earliest  Latin 
translation  of  the  Bible  was  made  in  North 
Africa.  TertuUian,  a.d.  200-245,  testifies  to 
the  general  currency  of  such  a  version.  It 
was  excessively  literal,  but  rude  and  rough, 
and  as  such,  offensive  to  the  ears  of  ItaUans. 
This  led  to  a  recension  being  made  in  North 
Italy  under  ecclesiastical  authority  in  the 
fourth  century  with  direct  reference  to  the 
Greek  text  of  the  New  Testament.  This 
version,  called  the  Italic  (Itala)  (see  B,alic 
Version),  is  recommended  by  St.  Augustine 
for  its  accuracy  and  perspicuity  {De  Doctr. 
Christ.  15)  and  was  preferred  by  him  to 
all  others.  It  was  afterwards  corrected 
from  the  emendations  of  St.  Jerome ;  and 
it  is  the  mixture  of  the  ancient  Italic 
version  with  the  corrections  of  St.  Jerome, 
that  is  now  called  the  Vulgate,  and  which 
the  Council  of  Trent  has  declared  to  be 
authentic.  The  version  of  St.  Jerome, 
however,  forms  the  main  part  of  the  Vul- 
gate, with  the  exception  of  some  of  the 
apocryphal  books,  and  the  Psalter.  The 
translation  of  the  latter  from  the  Hebrew 
was  not  adopted  publicly  by  the  Western 
Church,  though  still  to  be  found  in  his 
works.  The  Psalter  was  twice  corrected 
by  him  from  the  old  Italic  version ;  the 
first  recension  was  for  a  long  time  used  in 
the  Roman  Church,  the  latter  was  first 
adopted  by  the  Churches  of  Gaul  and 
Britain,  and  was  finally  adopted  by  the 
Western  Church  by  an  ordinance  of  Pius  V. 
The  old  Roman  Psalter  is  still,  however, 
used  at  the  Vatican,  and  at  St.  Mark's, 
Venice  (See  Hieron.  Praif.  in  Josh.  ;  Prssf. 
Post.  inPs.  Apol.  c.  Buff.  ii.  24 ;  Ep.  23,ad 
iMcin.  135,  ad  Sunn,  et  Fret. ;  Aug.  Ep. 
88,  ad  Hieron. ;  Ep.  97,  de  Boctr.  Chr.  ii. 
11). 

A  revision  of  the  Vulgate  was  made  by 
order  of  Sixtus  V.,  and  published  at  Rome 
in  1590.  But  this,  though  pronounced  by 
papal  authority  to  be  authentic,  became 
such  an  object  of  ridicule  among  the  learned 
from  its  gross  inaccuracies,  that  his  suc- 
cessor, Gregory  XIV.,  caused  it  to  be  sup- 
pressed, and  another  autlientic  Vulgate  was 
published  in  1592,  by  Clement  VIIL— 
Walton's  Prolegomena;  Hodius,   de  Bibl. 


WAFER  BREAD 

Text.  Orig ;  Home's  Introd, ;  "  Vulgate  "  in 
Diet.  ofBihh. 

The  Vulgate  of  the  New  Testament  is 
generally  preferred  by  the  Romanists  to  the 
common  Greek  text.  The  priests  read  no 
other  at  the  altar ;  the  preachers  quote  no 
other  in  the  pulpit,  nor  the  divines  in  the 
schools  (See  Bible). 


w. 

WAFER  BREAD.  Bread  used  in  the 
Eucharist  in  mediajval  times,  and  still  pre- 
ferred to  ordinary  bread  by  the  Romanists, 
the  Lutheran  Protestants,  and  others,  in 
the  celebration  of  that  holy  sacrament. 

I.  It  seems  certain  that  in  the  primitive 
Church  neither  unleavened  bread  nor  wafers 
were  used.  Ancient  writers  say  that  the 
bread  used  was  common  bread,  such  as  was 
made  for  their  own  use  (Ambros.  de  Sacram. 
lib.  iv.  c.  4).  It  was  also  a  charge  against  the 
Ebionites  that  they  celebrated  in  unleavened 
bread,  and  water  only  (Epiphan.  Exr.  30 ; 
Ebionit.  n.  16).  The  bread  generally  used 
was  expressly  called  "  fermentum,"  and 
though  this  is  explained  by  the  schoolmen, 
who  claimed  primitive  custom  for  unleavened 
bread,  as  the  eulogia,  or  panis  henedictus, 
which  was  blessed  for  such  as  did  not  com- 
municate. Pope  Innocent  I.  plainly  says  that 
it  refers  to  the  sacrament  itself  (Innoc.  Ep. 
ad  Decentium,  c.  5).  Moreover,  no  Greek 
writer  before  Michael  Cerularius,  who  lived 
c.  A.D.  1051,  objected  to  the  use  of  un- 
leavened bread  in  the  Roman  Church,  which 
would  seem  to  show  that  it  was  not  exten- 
sively used  before  that  time.  Even  some 
Roman  writers  speali  of  the  custom  as 
erroneous  (Bingham,  xv.  2). 

How  the  change  in  this  matter  was  made, 
and  the  exact  time  when,  is  not  easily  deter- 
mined. Cardinal  Bona's  conjecture  seems 
probable  enough  ;  that  it  crept  in  upon  the 
people's  leaving  off  to  make  their  oblations 
in  common  bread;  which  occasioned  the 
clergy  to  provide  it  themselves,  and  they, 
under  pretence  of  decency  and  respect, 
brought  it  from  leaven  to  unleaven,  and 
from  a  loaf  of  common  bread,  that  might  be 
broken,  to  a  nice  and  delicate  wafer,  formed 
in  the  figure  of  a  Denarius,  or  penny,  to 
represent  the  pence,  for  which  our  Saviour 
was  betrayed ;  and  then  also  the  people, 
instead  of  offering  a  loaf  of  bread,  as  fonnerly, 
were  ordered  to  offer  a  penny,  which  was 
either  to  be  given  to  the  poor,  or  to  be  ex- 
pended upon  something  pertaining  to  the 
sacrifice  of  the  altar  (Bona,  JRer.  Lilury. 
lib.  vi.). 

The   alteration  in  the  eucharistic  bread 


WAGER 


775 


occasioned  great  disputes  between  the  East- 
ern and  Western  Churches. 

11.  The  first  Common  Prayer  Book  of 
King  Edward  VI.  enjoins  unleavened  bread 
to  be  used  throughout  the  whole  kingdom 
for  the  celebration  of  the  Eucharist.  It  was 
ordered  to  be  round,  in  imitation  of  the 
wafers  used  by  the  G-reek  and  Roman 
Churches;  but  it  was  to  be  without  all 
manner  of  print,  the  wafers  usually  having 
the  impression  either  of  a  crucifix  or  the 
holy  lamb ;  and  something  more  large  and 
thicker  than  the  wafers,  which  were  of  the 
size  of  a  penny.  This  rubric,  affording 
matter  for  scruple,  was  set  aside  at  the  re- 
view of  the  liturgy  in  the  fifth  of  King 
Edward  ;  and  another  inserted  in  its  room, 
which  still  exists,  by  which  it  is  declared 
sufficient  that  tJie  bread  be  such  as  is  usually 
eaten.  By  the  injunctions  of  Queen  Eliza- 
beth, wafer  bread  seems  to  have  been  again 
enjoined,  for  among  other  orders  this  was 
one  :  "  For  the  more  reverence  to  be  given 
to  these  holy  mysteries — the  sacramental 
bread,  &c.,  made  and  foimed  plain  without 
any  figure  thereupon,  of  the  same  fineness 
and  fashion  round,  though  somewhat  bigger 
in  compass  and  thickness,  as  the  usual  bread 
and  wafers,  heretofore  called  singing  cakes, 
which  served  for  the  use  of  private  mass." 
Archbishop  Parker,  being  asked  for  an  ex- 
planation, wrote :.  "  It  shall  suffice,  I 
expound,  where  there  either  wanteth  such 
fine  usual  bread,  or  superstition  be  feared  in 
the  wafer  bread,  they  may  have  the  com- 
munion in  fine  usual  bread ;  which  is  rather 
a  toleration  in  these  two  necessities  than  is 
in  plain  ordering,  as  it  is  in  the  injunction  " 
(Corresp.  p.  376).  Archbishop  Grindal, 
Parker's  successor,  at  one  time  disapproved 
the  use  of  wafer  bread  which  prevailed  in 
the  Churches;  but  afterwards  he  seems  to 
have  been  satisfied  with  it,  as  his  friend  and 
adviser,  Peter  Martyr,  informed  him  that 
no  contention  on  the  subject  existed  on  the 
Continent.  There,  as  in  the  existing  Church 
of  England,  unleavened  bread  was  generally 
used  (Hook's  Archbishops,  x.  42). 

It  was  the  custom  in  Westminster  Abbe}', 
and  in  the  Royal  Chapels,  and  the  practice 
of  such  men  as  Bishop  Andrewes,  to  use 
wafers,  but  "  for  peace  sake,"  where  wafers 
were  objected  to,  plain  and  pure  wheaten 
bread  was  allowed.  It  has  been  decided  by 
the  Privy  Council  that  it  not  only  may,  but 
must  be  common  bread;  the  Injunctions, 
according  to  them,  being  of  no  validitj' 
against  the  rubric,  while  the  Advertisements 
having  been  made  under  Act  of  Parliament, 
and  not  contrary  to  the  rubric,  are  an  indica- 
tion of  its  meaning — i.e.  of  the  word  "  re- 
tained "  in  the  Ornaments  rubric  (But  see 
A  dvert  isements). 

WAGER  (See  Battle  and  Ordeal). 


776 


WAKE 


WAKE  {^^  Dedication). 

WALDENSES  (See  Albigenses).  A  sect 
which  derived  its  name  from  Peter  sur- 
named  Valdus  from  his  native  place  Val- 
dum  or  VaUdium,  a  town  in  tlie  Marsh  of 
Lyons.  He  was  a  merchant  of  Lyons  about 
A.D.  1160.  From  the  perusal  of  the  Scrip- 
tures and  other  writings,  and  from  comparing 
the  doctrines  of  Scripture  with  the  supersti- 
tions and  practices  of  the  age  in  which  he 
lived,  Waldo  perceived  the  corruption  of  the 
existing  mediaeval  Church,  and  in  advance 
of  his  age,  became  a  reformer.  He  shared 
the  fate  of  those  who  are  so  circumstanced. 
He  had  many  followers,  and  exposed  both 
himself  and  them  to  suspicion  and  persecu- 
tion. They  aimed  rather  at  redressing 
abuses  in  morals  and  discipline  than  cor- 
ru[itions  in  doctrine.  It  is  probable  that, 
in  attacking  error,  the  Waldenses  them- 
selves sometimes  became  erroneous.  They 
are  accused  of  having  maintained  the  un- 
lawfulness of  oaths  and  of  infant  baptism, 
and  of  being  seditious.  These  charges 
were  easily  made,  but  writers  of  celebrity 
have  undertaken  to  confute  them.  The 
marvel  is.  that,  when  every  attempt  was 
made  to  blacken  their  character,  the  success 
of  their  accusers  was  not  greater  than  it  has 
proved  to  be.  It  is  certain  that  tliey  were 
austere,  if  not  morose,  in  their  practice ; 
that  they  prohibited  wars  and  lawsuits, 
penal  punishments,  and  all  attempts  to  ac- 
quire wealth. 

Those  of  them  who  dwelt  in  the  valleys  of 
Piedmont  in  the  seventeenth  century  were 
subjected  by  the  Church  of  Kome  to  the 
most  barbarous  and  inhuman  persecutions, 
especially  in  the  years  1655,  1656,  and  1696. 
The  most  horrible  scenes  of  violence  and 
hloodshed  were  exhibited  in  this  theatre  of 
papal  tyranny,  and  the  Waldenses  at  last 
owed  their  existence  and  support  to  the 
interference  of  the  English  and  Dutch 
governments  (See  Faber,  Oa  the  Waldenses 
arid  Albigenses,  and  Dr.  Maitland,  Facts  and 
Documents,  <fcc.). 

WARBURTONIAN  LECTUEE.  A 
lecture  founded  by  Bishop  Warburton,  to 
prove  the  truth  of  revealed  religion  in  gene- 
ral, and  the  Christian  in  particular,  from 
the  completion  of  the  prophecies  in  the  Old 
and  New  Testament  which  relate  to  the 
Christian  Church,  especially  to  the  apostasy 
of  papal  Eome.  To  be  preached  at  Lincoln's 
Inn. 

WAEDEN.  The  head  of  some  college.s, 
and  the  superior  of  some  conventual  churches, 
in  which  the  chapter  remains,  is  called  a 
warden.  The  head  of  the  collegiate  church 
of  Galway  is  called  warden,  as  was  the  case 
at  Manchester,  till  the  erection  of  the  colle- 
giate church  there  into  a  cathedral. 

WATCHERS  (See  Acometie). 


WATER,  HOLY 

WATCHING  LOFTS.  Positions  from 
which  the  great  shrines  were  watched.  At 
Oxford  and  at  St.  Alban's  the  loft  is  a 
beautiful  structure  of  wood;  at  Lichfield  it 
is  a  gallery  over  the  door  of  the  sacristy ; 
at  Worcester  it  is  a  stone  oriel ;  at  West- 
minster there  is  one  over  Henry  VI.'s 
chantry  (Walcott's  Sac.  Arch.  p.  609).  [H.} 

WAYSIDE  CROSSES.  These  were,  in 
olden  times,  very  numerous,  and  gave  their 
name  to  several  places  or  districts.  They 
were  erected  (1)  as  marks  of  the  boundary 
of  a  monastic,  capitular  or  parochial  juris- 
diction; (2)  to  commemorate  a  battle,  as 
the  Neville's  Cross  near  Durham ;  (3)  to 
mark  the  halting-place  of  a  burial  procession, 
as  the  fifteen  "  Queen  Eleanor  Crosses,"  of 
which  three  remain  at  Geddington,  North- 
ampton, and  Waltham ;  (4)  as  memorials  of 
any  violent  dtath ;  (5)  as  stations  or 
preaching-places,  whence  they  were  some- 
times called  "weeping-crosses,"  as  at 
Shrewsbury.  There  are  remains  of  way- 
side crosses  near  Doncaster,  and  at  Braith- 
well,  also  at  Nevern,  Carew,  and  Newmarket. 
Crosses  were  often  erected  at  cross-roads, 
with  inscriptions  inviting  the  prayers  of  the 
traveller  (Walcotfs  Sac.  Arch.  p.  610).   [H.] 

WATER,  HOLY.  Water  which  has 
been  blessed  by  a  priest,  usually  placed  in  a 
basin,  called  the  holy  water  stoup,  at  the 
entrance  of  the  church.  The  primary  idea 
was,  that  the  hands  of  the  worshipijers 
might  be  washed,  and  "pure  hands  lifted 
up  in  prayer ; "  afterwards  it  symbolised 
their  purification  from  defilement  before 
engaging  in  prayer.  Then  the  idea  came 
in  that  some  intrinsic  benefit  resulted  from 
the  physical  application  of  the  holy  water, 
indei)endent  of  its  mystic  meaning.  It  is- 
not  used  in  the  Church  of  England,  nor 
can.  it  be  traced  to  primitive  times. 

The  only  holy  water  in  the  Apostolic 
age,  and  that  immediately  succeeding,  ex- 
cept the  water  which  was  mingled  with  the 
wine  at  the  Eucharist,  was  that  which  was 
used  at  the  Sacrament  of  Baptism  (See  Dap- 
tism).  This  came  afterwards  to  be  regarded 
not  only  as  the  outward  and  visible  sign  of 
the  regeneration  of  the  person  baptized,  but 
as  of  miraculous  efiicacy.  St.  Augustine 
of  Hippo  speaks  of  persons  bringing  their 
children  to  be  baptized,  because  "by  this 
remedy  they  would  retain  their  bodily  health  " 
(ijp.  xcviii.  5).  The  water  blessed  for  the 
baptismal  sei-vice  was  regarded  as  holy, 
and  carried  off  in  vessels,  to  he  used  in 
sprinkling  families,  houses  and  possessions, 
in  expectation  of  a  blessing  thereby  {Ordo. 
Mom.  i.  42).  St.  Chrysostom  speaks  of 
persons  keeping  the  water  consecrated  at 
the  Baptisms  at  Epiphany  throughout  the 
year— doubtless  as  a  sort  of  charm — and  this 
water  never,  as  was  asserted,  became  cor- 


WEDNESDAY 

rupted  (de  liapt.  Christi,  sec.  2).  It  is  not 
difficult  to  see  how  this  led  to  the  consecra- 
tion of  holy  water  apart  from  the  office  of 
Baptism.  Jt  has  been  supposed  by  some 
that  the  benediction  of  the  water,  distinct 
from  Baptism,  was  enjoined  by  Alexander 
I.,  bishop  of  Eome,  a.d.  109  (Walcott's 
Sac.  Arch.  314).  But  the  mention  of  it  is 
in  the  forged  decretals,  ascribed  indeed  to 
Alexander,  but  probably  comjwsed  about 
A.D.  850  (See  Decretals).  In  the  "  Apos- 
tolic Constitutions,"  directions  are  given  for 
the  benediction  of  water,  with  oil,  "  for  the 
imparting  health,  putting  to  flight  devils, 
scattering  every  evil  design,  through 
Christ."  But  this  is  given  in  the  8th  book, 
in  which  there  were  no  doubt  cornipt 
additions  inserted  much  later  than  the 
reputed  date  of  the  former  cauons  (viii.  c. 
29).  It  seems  however  certain  that  before 
the  8th  century  water  was  blessed  for  the 
purpose  of  exorcising  evil  spirits  in  houses 
if  not  in  persons. 

In  the  Pontifical  of  Egbert,  who  was 
archbishop  of  York  a.d.  732,  there  are 
forms  of  prayer  for  blessing  the  water  to  be 
used  in  the  consecration  of  a  church  (Pont. 
Egb.  Surtees  Soo.  1852).  And  these  seem 
to  have  been  derived  from  the  Sacramen- 
taries  of  Grelasius  and  Gregory  (Liturg. 
Rom.  Vet.,  Murat.  tom.  i.  col.  738 ;  torn.  ii. 
coL  225).  They  have  reference  to  places, 
not  to  persons.  The  sprinkling  of  persons 
with  holy  water,  however,  is  of  ancient 
date,  for  there  is  a  charge  of  Leo  IV.  to  his 
clergy  in  847,  in  which  he  urges  the 
priests  to  "bless  water  wherewith  the 
people  may  be  sprinkled."  This  would 
seem  to  show  that  the  use  had  been  in 
existence  previously  {Gone.  Labh.  t.  viii.  c. 
37). 

Stoups  for  the  holy  or  consecrated  water 
are  to  be  found  in  many  churches  in  Eng- 
land. But  since  the  Keformation,  "  holy 
water  "  has  had  no  place  in  our  Church,  on 
account  of  the  superstitions  which  were 
connected  with  it.     [H.] 

WEDNESDAY  (Old  English,  Wodens 
dmg,  "Woden's  day).  This  day  has  been 
marked  in  many  cases  by  the  Church  with 
especial  observance.  Thus  it  was  ofteu  added 
to  Friday  as  a  weekly  fast,  and  in  our  own 
Church  it  is  numbered  among  the  rogation 
and  ember  days;  besides  which,  throngh- 
out  the  year  the  Litany  is  appointed  to  be 
sung  or  said  on  Wednesday,  as  well  as  on 
Sunday  and  Friday  after  Morning  Prayer. 

WESLEY ANS  (See  Metliodists). 

WESTMINSTEK  ASSEMBLY  (See 
Assembly  of  Divines'). 

WESTMINSTER  CONFESSION  (See 
Confessions  of  Faith). 

WHITSUNDAY.  One  of  the  great 
festivals  of  the  Church,  held  in  commemora- 


WHITSUNDAY 


777 


tion  of  the  descent  of  the  Holy  Ghost  on 
the  day  of  Pentecost. 

I.  The  word  TTfmjKoor^,  sometimes  called 
by  Latin  writers  quinquagesima,  was  in  the 
primitive  times  used  either  for  the  whole 
period  of  fifty  days  from  Easter  to  Whit- 
sunday, or  for  the  festival  day  itself,  i.e.  the 
fittieth  day  from  the  morrow  of  the  Passover 
Sabbath.  This  is  in  accordance  with  the 
original  institution,  "  Ye  shall  count  from 
the  morrow  after  the  Sabbath ;  from  that 
day  seven  weeks  shall  be  complete  "  (Lev.. 
xxiiL  15). 

It  is  mentioned  as  a  separate  feast  of  the' 
Christian  Church  by  the  earliest  writers,  as 
Irenasus  (JFragm.  dePasch.in  Just.  Mart.) ; 
TertuUian  (de  Coron.  3 ;  de  Idol.  4,  &c.) ; 
Origen  {cont.  Cels.  viii.).  The  season  be- 
tween Easter  and  Pentecost  was  considered 
a  continuous  festival.  TertuUian  speaks  of 
it  as  "  latissimum  spatium,"  and  says  that 
it  is  unlawful  to  fast  then,  or  to  worship 
kneeling  (de  Coron.  ut  sup.).  This  rule  was 
also  laid  down  in  several  councils,  notably 
that  of  Kicaja,  a.d.  325  (Can.  20,  Labbe,  ii. 
37),  and  Baptisms  were  permitted  during 
the  whole  time,  though  afterwards  they 
were  restricted  to  the  vigil  of  the  festival 
(TertuU.  de  Bapt.  c.  19  ;  Hieron.  Com.  in 
Zach.  xiv.  8 :  JEp.  Ixi.). 

II.  The  origin  of  the  word  Whitsunday 
has  been  much  debated.  The  conjecture  of 
Hamon  L'Estrange  that  it  is  derived  from 
the  French  Huiet,  which  signifies  eight,  and 
would  imjily  the  eighth  Sunday  from  Easter, 
need  hardly  be  considered  (Riddell,  p.  681).. 
But  it  has  been  also  connected  with  the 
word  Pentecost  through  the  German.  Dr. 
Neale  (Essays  on  Liturgiology)  traces  it. 
thus :  Pentecost,  Pingsten,  Whingsten, 
German  Pfngsten,  English  Whitsun.  And 
this  theory  has  been  held  by  several  writers. 
The  Germans  indeed  have  their  Pfingsten 
Woche,  in  correspondence  with  our  Whitsun 
week.  But  the  derivation  is  hardly  tenable, 
for  neither  Pfingsten  nor  Wliingsten  ever 
existed  in  English.  Another  derivation  is- 
from  witan,  German  vrissen,  from  which  the 
Saxon  parliament  got  its  name^of  Witana- 
gemote.  If  thi.s  is  accepted  it  would  refer 
to  the  wit,  or  special  wisdom  which  was 
inspired  into  the  Apostles  on  the  day  o£ 
Pentecost.  A  writer  of  the  fourteenth 
century  says : 

"  This  date  Wit  sonday  is  cald 
For  wisdom  and  wit  seuene  fald 
Was  gouea  to  the  Apostles  as  tliis  dale." 

{_Cavib.  Univ.  MSS.  Dd.  I.  i.  p.  234). 

This  would  point  to  the  word  being  de- 
rived from  witan  or  wit,  and  the  spelling, 
has  sometimes  been  regarded  as  evidence. 
But  we  have  to  remember  that  in  early  and 
mediaeval  times  the  spelling)  in  all  cases,, 
was  most  arbitrary.     Thus  in  this  particular 


WHITSUNDAY 


"778 


instance  we  have  Hwit  Wijt,  Wife,  Whit 
and  Wit,  &c.,  as  prefixes.  In  a  MS.  of  the 
"  Ancien  Rivole  "  (c.  a.d.  1255)  the  word  is 
spelt  hwitsunnedei,  but  in  a  later  copy  it  is 
■witsunnedei.  In  the  four  versions  of  the 
"  Cursor  Mundi "  (14th  century)  there  are 
the  terms  Wiji  sundai,  Wit  sonday,  Witt 
■Sunday  and  Witsonen  day.  In  the  "  Promp- 
torium  Parvulorum  "  (A.D.  1440),  the  words 
WTiysscm  tyde  and  Whitsonday  are  both 
used.  Chaucer  wrote  Whysson  day  {Bo- 
iTiaunt  of  the  Rose),  and  in  the  north  of 
England  the  word  Whissen  is  still  used. 
Wiclif  wrote  it  Witsun  tide.  The  spelling 
therefore  throws  no  light  on  the  subject,  but 
for  other  reasons  philologists  now  are  of 
■opinion  that  the  derivation  from  "  white  "  is 
the  probable  one.  Hwit  is  the  old  English 
form  corresponding  to  the  modern  word 
"  white."  la  the  Ancient  Saxon  Chronicle, 
under  date  a.d.  1067,  these  words  occur: 
"And  Ealdred  Arceb.  hig  gehalgode  (hal- 
lowed) to  cwene  (queen)  on  Westmynstre 
on  Hwitan  Sunnau  daeg."  The  "h"  in 
hwit,  as  in  otlier  words  beginning  with 
"  hw,"  was  soon  after  generally  omitted  or 
transposed,  and  so  hwit  or  "  white  "  became 
wit,  and  wit  became  whit,  A  similar  change, 
.among  others,  may  be  given  in  the  common 
relative  who,  which  was  in  Saxon  "  hwa." 
The  change  from  the  long  "  i "  to  the  short 
has  taken  place  in  many  words  and  places, 
as  whitlow,  Saxon  hwit  and  low,  a  flame ; 
whittle,  Saxon  hwitel ;  Whitchurch,  Whitby, 
&c. ;  and  in  some  cases  in  even  more 
shortened  form,  as  Wheddon,  on  Exmoor, 
from  Whitedown,  then  Whitdown  and 
Wheddon.  The  Saxon  hwit  being  the  same 
.as  our  "  white,"  seems  to  make  the  deriva- 
tion clear.  It  may  be  added  that  the 
Icelandic  name  Hvita-sunnu-dagr,  and  the 
Welsh  name  Sul  Owyn,  which  goes  back  as 
far  as  the  laws  of  Howel  the  Good  (c.  a.d. 
907),  both  mean  White  Sunday.  It  is 
objected  to  this  derivation  that  the  Church 
had  in  early  times  already  a  White  Sunday, 
i.e.  the  Dominica  in  Albis,  the  first  Sunday 
.after  Easter,  when  the  chrisoms  were  worn 
ifor  the  last  time  (Procter,  p.  290,  note). 
But  it  must  be  remembered  that  the  feast  of 
Pentecost  was  also  a  great  time  for  the 
administratiou  of  the  baptismal  rite,  to  which 
reference  has  been  made  above,  and  that 
the  neophytes  then  put  on  their  white 
<;hrisoms  (Bingham,  xi.,  vi.  7).  In  fact  these 
two  festivals  of  Easter  and  Pentecost  were 
the  only  times  when  adult  baptism  was 
allowed  in  early  times  in  the  Western 
•Church,  except  in  the  case  of  the  sick, 
though  in  the  Eastern  Church  the  Epiphany 
was  added  (Greg.  Naz.  Orat.  xl.,  de  Bapt^. 
It  is  probable  that  the  later  time  was  pre- 
iferred  in  these  cold  climates  to  the  earlier, 
and  hence  the  .  second  "  White  Sunday." 


WICLIFITES 

Wheatly  judiciously  avoids  the  question,  or 
rather  takes  the  two  derivations,  hwit  and 
witan.  "It  was  styled,"  he  says,  "Whit 
Sunday,  partly  because  of  the  vast  diffusion 
of  light  and  knowledge  which  were  then 
shed  upon  the  Apostles  in  order  to  the 
enlightening  of  the  world,  but  principally 
from  the  white  garments  which  they  which 
were  baptized  at  this  time  put  on."  It  is 
to  be  observed  tliat  the  Prayer  Book  adopts 
the  spelling  Whitsunday,  except  in  the 
Table  of  Proper  Psalms,  where  it  is  Whit 
Sunday,  and  we  commonly  speak  of  Whitsun 
week,  Whitsun-Monday,  these  being  only 
shortened  forms  for  Whitsunday-week,  &c. 

III.  The  similar  harmony  of  Epistle, 
Gospel,  Collect,  Lessons  and  Psalms,  that 
has  been  pointed  out  upon  Christmas,  and 
Easter,  and  Ascension,  may  be  observed  on 
this  day.  The  Collect  is  from  the  Gregorian 
Sacramentary.  It  was  formerly  used  every 
day  at  Lauds,  and  was  translated  into 
Enghsh  at  least  a  century  and  a  half  before 
the  Prayer  Book  was  set  forth.  It  appears 
in  all  the  English  Prymers.  The  Epistle  is 
according  to  the  Eastern  rule  (Acts  ii.  1-11), 
whereas  in  the  Salisbury  Use  it  was 
Acts  X.  34-47.  But  the  Gospel  is  the  same 
as  in  the  Salisbury  Use  (St.  John  xiv. 
15-31).  Whitsun  week  is  one  of  the 
canonical  Ember  seasons  (see  Emher  Days), 
the  summer  ordinations  taking  place  on 
Trinity  Sunday. 

It  is  iuteresting  to  note  that  on  Whit- 
sunday (June  9)  in  the  year  1549  the  Book 
of  Common  Prayer  in  Enghsh  was  first  used 
instead  of  the  Latin  OfSces.  No  doubt  the 
day  was  chosen,  for  the  book  was  ready 
some  time  before,  as  a  devout  trust  that 
the  Holy  Ghost  was  with  the  Church  of 
England  in  the  important  step  then  taken 
(Blunt's  Diet.  Doct.  Theol. ;  E.  Daniel,  P.B. ; 
Bkeat's  Etymolog.  Diet. ;  Blunt's  Annot. 
P.  £.;  Wheatly;  Procter;  Bishop  Barry: 
in  loc.).     pi.] 

WICLIFITES.  The  followers  of  John 
Wiclif,  Doctor  and  Professor  of  Theology  at 
Oxford,  and  afterwards  Rector  of  Lutter- 
worth, in  Leicestershire,  and  justly  called 
the  first  reformer.  The  period  of  his  greatest 
activity  hes  between  the  years  360-380. 
He  died  in  384.  His  followers  were  also 
called  Lollards  (see  Lollards),  but  they 
did  not  behave  with  that  moderation  which 
Wiclif  inculcated.  His  ideas  were  briefly 
these  :  "  The  Scriptures  ought  to  be  in  the 
vulgar  tongue,  contain  aU  things  necessary 
to  salvation,  may  be  understood  by  every 
well-disposed  man ;  he  declared  against  tra- 
ditions, the  popes'  authority,  their  power 
over  the  temporaUties  of  kings,  and  pro- 
nounced the  pope  to  be  the  chiefest  anti- 
christ. He  taught  that  the  Church  of  Rome 
may  err ;  he  rejected  merit  of  works,  and 


WINDOWS 

transubstantiation,  and  owned  but  two 
sacraments ;  he  was  against  images,  auricular 
confession,  pardons,  indulgences,  and  mon- 
astic vows;  be  approved  the  marriage  of 
priests,  and  was  the  most  strenuous  opponent 
of  the  Mendicant  Friars  (Introduction  to 
the  Fasciculi  Zizaniorum  Kolls  Series; 
Lives  of  Wiclif  by  Dr.  Vaughan  and  Mr. 
Le  Bas). 

WINDOWS.  The  general  characteristics 
of  the  windows  of  the  Succession  styles  of 
church  architecture  are  so  well  known,  that 
little  need  be  said  of  tbem,  and  we  must 
refer  to  architectural  books  for  details,  which 
cannot  be  appreciated  without  good  draw- 
ings :  mere  lines  of  tracery  are  entirely 
misleading  as  to  effects,  which  in  a  great 
measure  depend  on  the  fitting  together  of 
ribs  of  stone  which  ought  never  to  be  much 
thinner  than  a  third  of  the  intervening 
lights.  Saxon,  Romanesque,  and  Norman 
windows  were  all  roundheaded,  and  generally 
single ;  but  occasionally  two  were  combined 
with  a  shaft  and  capital  between  them  and 
another  round  arch  thrown  over  both.  Such 
are  the  windows  both  of  the  belfry  and 
triforium  of  the  St.  Alban's  tower  ;  the 
earliest  great  one  now  remaining.  The 
shafts  of  that  triforium  are  supposed  to  have 
come  from  the  earlier  Saxon  church. 

There  were  also  a  few  completely  circular 
Norman  windows,  of  which  much  the  finest 
seems  to  have  been  at  Iffley,  but  it  is  gone 
except  in  the  pages  of  Eickman.  It  is  still 
more  remarkable  becau.se  it  included  eight 
other  circles  round  a  central  octagon,  with 
some  beautiful  connecting  lines.  The  north 
transept  great  circle  at  Lincoln  has  only  four 
round  arches  radiating  from  the  centre,  and 
sixteen  uncusped  circles,  and  is  therefore 
Norman  in  design  though  considered  to  be 
of  about  A.D.  1200. 

Early  English  windows,  as  everybody 
knows,  were  purely  lancets,  but  too  many 
people  do  not  know  that  they  were  seldom 
sharper  than  an  equilateral  arch,  except 
where  it  was  necessary  to  raise  them  in 
order  to  bring  a  narrower  arch  up  to  the 
same  height  as  a  voider  one  close  to  it. 
Later  in  the  style  two  lancets  were  put 
together.  That  however  was  not  a  universal 
rule  without  exceptions,  as  all  over  Salisbury, 
and  later  still  a  circle  was  put  over  them 
and  another  arch,  which  gradually  expanded 
into  the  Geometrical  or  Early  Decorated 
style  of  window,  by  far  the  grandest  of  all. 
Tlie  largest  window  of  that  style,  the  east 
of  Lincoln,  is  of  the  simplest  construction, 
made  by  successive  duplications  until  eight 
upright  lights  are  reached,  with  circles  first 
over  two,  then  over  four,  and  finally  over 
all  the  eight,  or  filling  the  whole  width  of 
the  arch.  Cusping  of  small  arches  in 
windows  came  in  with  this  style,   which 


WINDOWS 


779 


immensely  increased  their  richness,  though 
it  was  not  always  used,  and  had  begun  in 
the  later  Early  English  times.  In  that  very 
Lincoln  window  the  "  lights  "  are  uncusped, 
but  all  the  circles  over  them  have  cusps, 
some  open  and  some  closed  or  solid.  Though 
that  is  the  largest  Geometrical  window, 
there  are  two  that  have  nine  lights,  viz. 
the  old  west  window  of  Exeter  and  the  new 
one  of  St.  Alban's.  Those  of  York  and 
Carlisle  (east)  also,  with  nine  lights,  are  of 
the  later  or  Flowing  Decorated  style,  which 
differs  from  the  Early  more  in  principle  of 
construction  or  design  than  in  appearance  at 
first  sight.  All  those  four  are  26  feet  wide, 
while  the  Lincoln  one  is  30. 

Most  writers  now  agree  that  the  division 
between  those  two  styles  is  the  true  dividing 
line  in  Gothic  architecture  between  its  rise 
and  its  decline.  Up  to  that  time  it  was 
always  adding  new  and  grander  features 
without  losing  any,  and  without  any  con- 
fusion of  parts  naturally  distinct,  and  care- 
fully preserving  horizontal  demarcations  as 
well  as  vertical.  A  glance  at  the  York  or 
Carlisle  windows  shows  two  fundamental 
changes:  the  capitals  of  the  mullions  are 
gone,  so  that  they  run  up  continuously  into 
the  tracery  without  any  horizontal  mark  to 
show  that  they  were  columns  supporting  a 
mass  of  perforated  wall  or  tracery ;  and  the 
tracery  itself  is  evidently  de.signed  for  the 
bars,  and  not  the  lights  seen  through  them, 
and  the  stone  is  treated  as  if  it  were  flexible, 
instead  of  as  a  series  of  balanced  arches, 
forming  circles  or  any  other  regular  figm-es. 
The  distinction  is  less  conspicuous  in  win- 
dows of  only  two  or  three  lights,  but  still  it 
is  there.  After  this  had  flourished  for  about 
forty  years,  the  tracery  again  became  rigid, 
apparently  from  mere  poverty  of  invention 
and  loss  of  architectural  genius,  and  they 
stiffened  into  mere  upright  bars,  and  a  sort 
of  pierced  panelling,  in  widths  halved  as 
you  go  up,  while  the  early  window  circles 
doubled  as  they  rose.  A  few  arches  were 
thrown  across  great  Perpendicular  windows 
here  and  there,  giving  them  an  appearance 
of  division  and  combination,  but  they  merely 
cut  across  all  the  vertical  lines  and  construc- 
tionally  do  nothing. 

Transoms  or  hoiizontal  ribs  across  the 
vertical  lights  are  almost  peculiar  to  Per- 
pendicular windows,  but  a  few  tall  Decor- 
ated ones  have  them,  or  where  there  was  some 
internal  reason  for  them.  The  enormously 
high  Perpendicular  windows  at  the  east 
and  west  of  Bath  abbey  have  respectively 
two  and  three  transoms.  Such  long  thin 
mullions  would  have  been  unsafe  without, 
or  at  any  rate  would  have  looked  so,  even 
if  stiffened  with  iron  bars,  and  architecture 
never  should  look  weak.  It  was  probably 
for  the  same  reason  that  the   twelve  tall 


780 


WINDOWS,  PAINTED 


windows,  sixty  feet  high,  in  the  tower  of  old 
St.  Paul's  had  a  number  of  small  transoms, 
set  back  more  like  iron  bars,  according  to  the 
pictures  of  that  building.  What  are  called 
"  spherical  triangle  "  windows,  or  equilateral 
triangles  with  curved  sides,  as  in  the  clear- 
story at  Lichfield,  and  in  the  top  of  the 
south  transept  of  York,  are  Early  Decorated. 
Vesica  are  drawn  as  two  equilateral  arches 
(or  thereabouts)  on  the  top  of  each  other, 
base  to  base,  and  the  bases  omitted ;  or  you 
'may  say  they  are  two  equal  arches  of  120 
meeting  each  other.  They  chiefly  belong 
to  the  Early  English  and  the  two  Decor- 
ated styles.  Square-headed  windows,  with 
one  or  two  mullions  and  simple  cusped 
tracery  over  them,  came  in  perhaps  late 
in  the  Early  English  style,  chiefly  for 
aisles,  and  continued  through  all  the  others 
till  square  ones  became  common,  as  the 
Perpendicular  sank  into  the  Tudor  style, 
and  the  chm-ch-building  of  the  middle  ages 
ceased  in  the  time  of  Henry  VIII.  Since 
then  there  has  been  no  original  style  of 
architecture,  but  only  compounds  and 
copies.  Probably  all  practicable  forms  had 
been  exhausted.  At  any  rate  it  is  mere 
nonsense  to  complain  that  original  styles 
are  no  longer  invented,  without  proving  that 
they  are  possible,  and  that  can  only  be 
proved  by  inventing  one — not  too  ugly  to 
use.  It  is  equal  nonsense  to  object  to 
Gothic  building  now  because  it  is  a  copy, 
when  every  alternative  must  be  just  as 
much  a  copy,  of  Greek  or  Boman  or  some 
other  dead  language  of  architecture. 

"  Jesse  windows "  are  a  base  kind  of 
Perpendicular,  with  ofi'shoots  like  boughs 
from  the  mullions.  Only  a  few  of  them 
exist,  but  quite  enough.  We  have  no 
such  large  wheel  windows  as  some  foreign 
ones.  They  belong  to  all  the  styles.  The 
south  one  of  Lincoln  is  much  later  than  the 
north,  and  in  the  Flowing  Decorated  style, 
which  does  not  suit  it  so  well.  There  is  a 
good  one  at  the  east  of  Durham,  and  two 
large  modem  ones  in  the  Westminster  tran- 
septs. The  finest  by  far  is  -in  the  south 
transept  of  York,  either  Early  English  or 
Geometrical.  And  Street  made  one  in  his 
new  west  front  and  nave  of  Bristol,  of  much 
the  same  character  as  the  Westminster 
ones.    [G.J 

WINDOWS,  PAINTED.  It  is  a  well- 
established  fact  that  glass,  both  white 
and  coloured  as  well  as  opaque  and  trans- 
parent, was  manufactured  by  the  ancient 
Egyptians.  But  it  was  used  by  them  princi- 
pally for  ornaments  and  utensils.  The  first 
undoubted  mention  of  the  insertion  of  glass 
in  windows  is  found  in  the  "  De  Opif.  Dei " 
of  Lactautius,  c.  8,  which  was  written  about 
the  end  of  the  3rd  century.  Leo  III.,  a.d. 
795-816,  adorned  the  windows  of  the  Lateran 


WINDOWS,  PAINTED 

with  coloured  glass.  And  the  art  of  glass 
painting  is  minutely  described  by  Theo- 
philus,  who  lived  in  the  10th  century,  in 
his  "  Divers.  Art.  Schedula."  The  glass  used 
in  glass  paintings  is  either  white  or  coloured. 
The  white  is  composed  of  silex  and  alkali 
"  fritted,"  i.e.  exposed  to  a  strong  fire  until 
vitrified,  and  then  formed  into  sheets.  The 
glass  is  then  "  annealed,"  i.e.  allowed  to  cool 
very  slowly  in  order  to  toughen  it. 

Coloured  glass  is  of  two  kinds,  (a)  "  pot- 
metal  "  glass,  i.e.  glass  coloured  through  the 
entire  substance,  and  (j3)  "covered"  or 
"  coated  "  glass,  i.e.  coloured  only  one  side. 
Coloured  glass  is  formed  by  adding  colouring 
matter  to  the  materials  of  white  glass  while 
in  fusion.  It  is  manufactured  in  sheets  in 
the  same  manner  as  other  glass. 

Methods.  Glass  painters  possess  the 
power  of  colouring  white  glass,  and  even 
varying  the  tints  of  coloured  glass,  by  means- 
of  stains  and  enamels.  There  are  three 
distinct  methods  of  staining  or  colouring. 
(1)  The  mosaic  method,  which  is  the  most 
simple.  Under  this  system  the  painter 
generally  arranged  the  glass  in  pieces  of 
white  and  coloured  glass  like  a  mosaic,  and 
only  used  two  pigments — a  yellow  stain  and 
a  brown  enamel.  The  main  outlines  of  the 
design  when  finished  were  formed  by  the 
connecting  leads,  and  each  colour,  roughly 
speaking,  represents  a  piece  of  glass.  (2)  In 
the  enamel  method  no  coloured  glass  is  used, 
but  the  design  is  painted  on  white  gla^s. 
This  method  is  the  most  difiicult  of  all, 
(3)  Tlie  mosaic  enamel  is  a  combination 
of  the  two  other  methods.  Under  each 
method  the  practical  course  of  proceeding  is 
much  the  same.  A  cartoon  of  the  design 
is  made,  and  the  pieces  of  glass  are  cut  to 
the  required  shape.  They  are  then  painted 
and  heated  to  redness  in  a  kiln,  i.e.  burnt, 
by  which  process  the  colours  are  perma- 
nently fixed.  The  number  of  burnings 
vary  according  to  circumstances. 

Styles. 
Early  Pointed, 
Decorated,        1280 
Perpendicular,  1380 
Cinque  Cento,  1500 


ending  about  1280 
„  1380 
,,  1530 
1550 


Intermediate  to  present  day. 

(1)  Early  Pointed  Style.  The  oldest 
painted  windows  known  to  exist  are  those 
of  the  Abbey  of  St.  Denys,  which  it  seems 
certain  were  executed  by  the  Abbd  Suger  in 
the  12th  century.  There  are  none  of  "quite 
so  early  a  date  as  these  in  England.  Early 
Enghsh  painted  windows  are  in  general 
almost  entirely  composed  of  coloured  or 
white  glass.  The  white  glass  is  covered 
with  patterns,  while  the  coloured  is  given 
up  to  figures,  and  there  is  generally  a  wide 
coloured  border.     The  colours  are  very  vivid 


WINDOWS,  PAINTED 

and  intense.  There  are  three  cUisses  of 
■coloured  windows  in  this  style — 

a.  Medallion  or  panel,  containing  small 
pictures  representing  some  historical  event 
or  some  theological  doctrine.  This  design 
is  probahly  confined  to  this  period,  but 
as  a  rule  mere  general  arrangement  affords 
scarcely  any  criterion  of  date. 

/3.  Figure  or  canopy  windows.  Windows, 
strictly  speaking,  come  under  this  head  which 
have  one  large  figure  under  a  low-crowned 
<;anopy  occupying  the  whole  window  within 
a  border,  or  where  two  or  more  such  figures 
are  placed  one  above  another.  The  canopy 
is  of  a  simple  and  rude  design,  and  the 
figure  is  executed  in  rich  colours  on  a 
coloured  ground. 

y.  Jesse  windows,  which  are  illuminated 
■charts  of  the  genealogy  of  Christ.  The 
main  stem  is  almost  hidden  by  figures,  and 
branches  spring  from  it  at  intervals  on  which 
are  placed  a  series  of  oval  panels,  one  above 
the  other,  in  which  the  principal  figures  are 
placed.  Smaller  attendant  figures  are  re- 
presented outside  the  panels  upon  lateral 
scrolls  of  foliage. 

The  foliage  in  this  style  is  very  conven- 
tional and  unnatural.  The  figures  are  tall 
and  badly  proportioned,  "but  are  often  grandly 
conceived,  and  the  faces  full  of  expression 
and  character.  The  glass  used  is  thick  and 
substantial. 

(2)  Decorated,  1280-1380.  In  this  style 
a  more  natural  form  of  foliage  is  used,  and 
the  colouring  is  rich  but  not  gay.  The 
yellow  stain  is  employed  for  the  first  time, 
and  its  lemon  colom-ed  tint  alters  very  much 
the  appearance  of  the  windows  of  this  period. 
Abrupt  alternation  of  masses  of  variegated 
colouring  with  masses  of  nearly  white  glass 
seems  to  have  been  a  favourite  practice  at 
this  time.  The  awangements  of  both 
individual  windows  and  of  their  general 
dispositions  were  very  various.  The  chancel 
of  Merton  Chapel,  Oxford,  York  Chapter 
House,  Lincoln  and  Hereford  Cathedrals, 
&c.,  present  good  examples  of  this  glass, 
remains  of  which  are  more  numerous  than 
of  that  of  any  other  period.  The  figures 
are  more  severe  in  drawing  than  in  the 
previous  style,  hut  more  refined,  the  dra- 
peries ampler  and  more  flowing,  and  the 
attitudes  forced  and  extravagant.  White 
glas~  is  often  used  for  the  naked  parts  of 
the  bodies,  and  the  hair  not  unfrequently 
stained  yellow.  The  canopies  of  this  pe- 
riod have  almost  invariably  flat  fronts,  and 
straight-aided  gables  over  the  main  arch- 
ways, with  high  spires  and  pinnacles.  The 
colouring  of  the  architectural  details  is 
capricious.  Borders  are  placed  round  all 
the  lights  with  a  pattern  of  conventional 
foliage,  or  an  heraldic  design,  e.g.  Stan- 
ford Church ,  Northamptonshire.    The  letters 


WINDOWS,  PAINTED 


781 


found   on   these    windows   are    Lombardic 
capitals. 

(3)  Perpendicular.  This  style  terminated 
with  the  use  of  Gothic  ornamental  details. 
An  especial  peculiarity  of  the  style  is  the 
substitution  of  flat  delicate  and  conventional 
ornaments  for  the  more  decided  and  naturally 
shaped  leaves  of  which  so  much  of  the 
detail  of  decorated  glass  painting  is  com- 
posed. The  Stipple  method  of  shading 
seems  to  have  heen  introduced  about  the 
beginning  of  the  15th  century,  and  a  taste 
for  broader  and  softer  colour  is  apparent. 
Hence  Perpendicular  windows  appear  paler 
and  less  rich  than  those  of  the  former  period, 
but  gain  in  general  effect.  The  canopies  of 
this  style  have  projecting  fronts  large  in 
proportion  to  the  figures,  and  they  also 
differ  from  the  previous  style  in  the  principal 
architectural  parts  being  left  white,  while 
the  details  are  stained  yellow,  and  thus  the 
picture  has  the  effect  of  being  framed  in 
white  and  yellow  glass.  The  figures  of  this 
period  are  better  drawn  and  less  fantastic 
than  in  the  earlier  periods,  and  heraldic 
decoration  was  much  in  fashion.  The  choir 
of  York  Cathedral,  Nettlestead  Church,  Kent, 
Canterbury  Cathedral,  and  Fairford  Chm-ch, 
Gloucestershire,  possess  good  examples  of 
this  style.  The  borders  resemble  those 
of  the  later  Decorated.  1'he  lettering  is 
black-letter,  and  the  beautiful  round  glass 
shown  in  John  van  Eyck's  pictures  began 
to  be  used  now. 

(4)  Cinque  Cento  Style  lasted  about  fifty 
years,  i.e.  from  1500-1550,  thus  overlapping 
the  Perpendicular  Period,  which  it  resembles, 
differing  principally  from  it  in  ornamental 
detail.  The  Italian  architecture  of  the  16th 
century  is  represented  in  the  windows  of 
this  date,  hence  the  name  of  the  style. 
Friezes,  arabesques,  &c.,  take  the  place  of 
the  Gothic  ornament.  The  figures  are  often 
in  the  dress  of  the  16th  century,  and  the 
whole  character  of  the  style  is  more  orna- 
mental and  less  severe  than  that  of  the 
Perpendicular.  Canopies  appear  generally 
to  be  confined  to  the  lower  lights.  There  is 
usually  one  large  canopy,  covering,  e.g.,  a 
group  of  benefactors.  The  choir  of  Brussels 
Cathedral  and  Auch  Cathedral  abroad, 
and  Kmg's  College,  Cambridge,  at  home, 
contain  beautilul  windows  of  this  date. 
The  profuse  emj.loyment  of  yellow  stain  is 
noticeable,  and  the  discontinuation  of  borders. 
An  architectural  screen  or  elevation  of  great 
and  small  arches  forms  a  frequent  back- 
ground, and  sometimes  festoons  are  hung 
across  the  front  of  the  principal  arch. 
Roman  and  black-letter  characters  are  used 
mdiscriminately  until  1530,  and  Arabic 
numerals. 

(5)  Intermediate.  This  style  divides  into 
periods,  i.e.  (a)  from  1550  to  about  1820,  and 


782 


WINDOWS,  PAINTED 


(|3),  since  that  date.  The  first  period  exhibits 
the  gvadual  dechne  of  the  art,  and  is  dis- 
tinguished by  the  use  of  enamel  colours 
discovered  in  the  16th  century.  This  pro- 
cess is  easy,  but  results  in  the  diminished 
transparency  and  brilliancy  of  the  picture. 
The  architectural  details  are  copied  from  the 
PaUadian  style  of  architecture.  The  con- 
trasts of  light  and  shade  are  not  kept  up,  and 
the  designs  become  less  effective.  After  the 
commencement  of  thelSth  century,  the  archi- 
tectural framework  is  dispensed  with.  In 
England,  glass  painting,  much  retarded  by 
the  ecclesiastical  struggles  in  the  reign  of 
Elizabeth,  made  considerable  progi-ess  during 
the  reigns  of  James  I.  and  Charles  I.  There 
are  many  windows  of  this  date  at  Oxford 
which  are  distinguished  by  their  landscape 
background.  With  the  Revolution  the  art 
came  to  a  standstill,  and  the  windows  after 
this  period,  as  at  Arundel  Castle,  or  in  the 
west  end  of  New  College  Chapel,  show  how 
terribly  the  art  had  declined.  The  revival 
of  the  Mosaic  system  in  England  and  the 
disuse  of  enamels  is  characterised  by  much 
strength  and  vividness  of  colour,  but  a  want 
of  originality  marred  the  improvement,  the 
artists  while  copying  the  imperfect  drawing 
of  earlier  styles,  often  failing  to  reproduce  the 
spirit  and  character  which  give  them  their 
beauty.  Glass  painting,  however,  has  since 
this  revival  been  making  rapid  strides,  and 
the  windows  of  the  more  famous  firms  of 
glass  stainers  of  the  present  day  almost  vie 
in  spirit,  vividness  of  colour  and  general 
effect,  with  the  most  boasted  specimens  of  the 
Middle  Ages  (See  Ancient  Glass  Paint- 
ings hy  an  Amateur,  &c.).     [F.  H.] 

A  few  years  ago  a  style  of  painted  glass 
came  partially  into  fashion  here,  which  goes 
by  the  name  of  Munich  glass,  and  of  which 
the  characteristics  are,  the  use  of  stronger 
and  darker  colours  and  a  more  pictorial  style, 
especially  in  introducing  shade  and  perspec- 
tive, which  were  completely  absent  from 
the  early  painted  windows.  Theoretically 
such  a  style  sounds  as  if  it  ought  to  be 
superior  to  the  other  ;  hut  theory  turns  out 
to  be  as  much  opposed  to  experience  in  this 
as  it  is  in  many  other  things.  Such  win- 
dows have  the  fatal  defect  of  shutting  out 
far  more  light  than  the  early  ones  ever  did ; 
and  in  themselves  they  have  a  narrow  escape 
of  looking  more  like  coloured  linen  blinds 
than  glass :  and  for  some  reason  or  other 
the  shading  which  is  necessary  to  produce 
pictorial  effects  gives  the  whole  an  opaque 
and  too  often  a  vulgar  look  of  being  only  a 
very  second-rate  picture.  In  short,  painted 
glass  is  something  sui  generis,  and  must  not 
be  considered  or  treated  as  a  picture.  The 
Cinque  Cento  style  above  mentioned  ap- 
proximated to  this  Munich  style,  and  is 
quite  unsuitable  for  Gothic  buildings;  at 


WISDOM 

any  rate,  many  churches  are  spoilt  by  first 
building  windows  which  are  only  large 
enough  to  light  the  place  properly  with 
"  white  "  or  plain  glass,  and  then  filling  them, 
with  painted  glass,  and  very  often  too  dark 
besides.  Clearstories  especially  ought  to  be 
kept  clear  of  it,  except  those  filled  with 
large  perpendicular  windows  designed  on 
purpose  for  it,  such  as  those  at  Bath  Abbey, 
for  example,  which  have  nevertheless  lost 
their  painted  glass  long  ago.  The  effect  of 
a  painted  window,  after  all,  depends  far 
more  on  the  character  of  the  glass  and  the 
general  colouring  of  the  window  than  on 
what  are  called  the  subjects;  and  conse- 
quently a  paper  picture  of  it  is  by  no 
means  sufficient  alone  to  enable  one  to  judge 
what  the  effect  of  the  window  will  be,  ex- 
cept negatively,  or  to  condemn,  an  obviously 
bad  one.     [G.] 

WINE,  EUCHAKISTIC.  Wine  has 
always  been  held  to  be  an  essential  element 
in  the  Holy  Communion.  Endeavours 
have  been  made  at  different  times  to  substi- 
tute water  (See  Aquarii;  Ehionites),  but 
this  has  never  been  allowed  by  the  Church. 
It  was  always  the  custom,  however,  to 
mingle  water  with  the  wine :  the  Jews  did 
this  in  the  Paschal  cup — the  "  Cup  of  Bless- 
ing " — and  it  seems  almost  certain  that  our 
Lord  used  the  mixture  at  the  institution  of 
the  Eucharist  (Maimonides,  lib.  de  Solemn. 
Pasch.  c.  7,  sect.  5;  St.  Cyprian,  Eja.  63, 
c.  7).  There  is  no  doubt  that  it  was  the 
custom  from  the  earliest  ages  of  the  Church 
to  mingle  water  with  the  wine,  Justin 
Martyr  (Apol.  i.),  Irenffius  (lib.  v.  c.  2), 
St.  Cyprian,  and  other  early  writers  bearing 
witness  to  the  fact  (See  Mixed  Chalice). 
The  Greeks  use  hot  water  with  the  wine,  ' 
following  the  liturgy  of  St.  Chrysostom, 
according  to  which  boiling  water  (ro  feoi/) 
is  to  be  poured  into  the  chalice  ^Lit.  St. 
Chrysost.  c.  34).  The  wine  used  has 
generally  been  red;  as  such  St.  Cyprian 
refers  to  it  {Ep.  63),  and  St.  Augustine  speaks 
of  the  tongue  being  empurpled  with  it  in 
the  Eucharist  (flom.  82,  in  Matt.  xxvi. 
34,  35).  Later  provincial  councils  ordered 
that  the  wine  should  always  be  red ;  but  in 
the  Eoman  Church  at  the  present  day  white 
wine  is  used.  In  the  seventeenth  century 
claret ;  in  the  eighteenth  sack  was  employed 
at  the  Holy  Communion  in  England.  At 
the  present  time  "  Tent,"  a  sweet,  red, 
Spanish  wine,  or  some  similar  wine,  not 
used  for  ordinary  consumption,  is  generally 
adopted.     [H.] 

WISDOM,  BOOK  OP.  An  apocryphal 
book  of  Scripture;  so  called  on  account  of 
the  wise  maxims  and  useful  instructions 
contained  therein. 

The  Book  of  Wisdom  is  commonly 
ascribed  to  King  Solomon,  either  becaiise 


WOED 

the  author  imitated  that  king's  maimer  of 
writing,  or  because  he  sometimes  speaks 
in  his  name.  But  it  is  certain  Solomon  was 
not  the  author  of  it ;  for  it  was  not  written 
in  Hebrew,  nor  was  it  inserted  in  the  Jew- 
ish canon,  nor  is  the  style  like  Solomon's : 
and  therefore  St.  Jerome  observes  justly, 
that  it  smells  strongly  of  the  Grecian 
eloquence;  that  it  is  composed  with  art 
and  method,  after  the  manner  of  the  Greek 
philosophers,  very  different  from  that  noble 
simplicity,  so  full  of  life  and  energy,  to  be 
found  in  the  Hebrew  books.  It  has  beeu 
attributed  by  many  of  the  ancients  to  Philo, 
a  Jew,  but  more  ancient  than  he  whose 
works  are  now  extant.  But  it  is  commonly 
ascribed  to  an  Hellenistic  Jew,  who  livtd 
since  Ezra,  and  about  the  time  of  the 
Maccabees  (See  Dr.  Wace,  Apocrypha ; 
Smith,  Diet.  Bible). 

WORD,  THE  (6  Aiyos).  The  only  be- 
gotten Son  of  the  Father,  the  uncreated 
Wisdom,  the  second  person  of  the  most  Holy 
Trinity,  equal  and  consubstantial  with  the 
Father,  the  Living  Word,  never  separated 
from  the  Father  (Origen,  in  Joann.  torn.  i.). 
St.  John  the  Evangelist,  more  expressly  than 
any  other,  has  opened  to  us  the  mystery  of 
the  Word  of  God,  when  he  tells  us,  "  In  the 
beginning  was  the  Word,  and  the  Word 
was  with  God,  and  the  Word  was  God. 
The  same  was  in  the  beginning  with  God. 
All  things  were  made  by  him,  and  without 
him  was  not  anything  made  that  was 
made."  The  Chaldee  paraphrasts,  the  most 
ancient  Jewish  writers,  generally  use  the 
name  (t<^DD),  Memra,  or  Word,  where  in 
other  places  is  used  the  name  Jehovah :  as 
for  examx^le  Ps.  ex.  1.  The  Lord  said 
mD*D  "unto  His  Word,"  i.e.  to  Christ. 
In  effect,  according  to  them,  it  was  Memra 
who  created  the  world ;  who  appeared  to 
Abraham  in  the  plain  of  Mamre;  and  to 
Jacob  at  Bethel.  It  was  Memra  to  whom 
Jacob  appealed  to  witness  the  covenant 
between  him  and  Laban.  The  same  Word 
appeared  to  Moses  at  Sinai;  gave  the  law 
to  the  Israelites;  spoke  face  to  face  with 
that  lawgiver ;  marched  at  the  head  of  that 
people ;  enabled  them  to  conquer  nations, 
and  was  a  consuming  fire  to  all  who  vio- 
lated the  law  of  the  Lord.  All  these 
characters,  where  the  paraphrast  uses  the 
word  Memra,  clearly  denote  Almighty  God. 
This  Word  therefore  was  God,  and  the 
Hebrews  were  of  this  opinion  at  the  time 
that  the  Targum  was  composed  (See 
Bishop  Bull  ore  the  Nicene  Creed,  i.,  i.  19 ; 
Pearson  ore  the  Creed,  Art.  ii.). 

WORKS.  The  doctrine  of  the  Church 
of  England  on  the  subject  of  works  is  to  be 
found  in  the  "  Articles  of  Religion,"  in  the 
Prayer  Book,  Nos.  xi.,  xii.,  xiii.  (See  Good 
WorJcs ;  Justification ;  SanctiflcatioTi). 


WORSHIP 


783; 


WORSHIP  (0.  E.  weorth-soypc,  worth 
and  ship,  the  latter  being  a  common  ter- 
mination as  in  lordship.  Probably  it  is 
derived  from  Sax.  scyppan,  to  form  or 
build).  I.  An  offering  of  praise  to  God.  In 
this  sense  worship  and  praise  are  almost 
synonymous,  as  used  in  many  passages  in 
Holy  Scripture,  such  as  "  0  worship  the^ 
Lord  in  the  beauty  of  Holiness  "  (See  Ps. 
xxix.  2:  xlvi.  2;  1  Chron.  xvi.  20;  St. 
Matt.  iv.  10,  &c.).  The  ceremonial  worship^ 
was  not  given  to  the  Jews  merely  as  a 
means  of  spiritual  education,  but  it  is 
throughout  regarded  as  having  reference  ta 
Him  in  Whose  service  it  was  used,  looking 
to  the  object  of  worship,  and  not  to  the 
worshippers.  So  when  the  Jewish  nation 
attained  its  highest  pitch  of  prosperity,  and 
probably  of  intellectual  as  well  as  spiritual 
progress,  in  the  reigns  of  David  and  Solomon, 
the  elaborate  system  of  ceremonial  worship 
was  developed  instead  of  being  narrowed. 
We  have  but  to  refer  to  the  books  of  the 
Kings  and  Chronicles  to  see  what  impor- 
tance was  given  at  that  time  to  ceremonial 
worship.  The  captives  "by  the  waters  of 
Babylon "  sat  down  and  wept  when  they 
remembered  the  songs  of  Sion.  And  when 
restored,  the  service  of  the  Temple  was 
attuned  to  the  worship  of  God.  Our 
Blessed  Lord  when  He  visited  the  Temple, 
and  both  at  the  commencement  and  end  of 
His  ministry  cast  out  those  who  made 
traffic  in  the  holy  place,  said  no  word 
against  the  ritual  of  worship  that  was 
held  therein,  but  Himself  went  to  the 
Temple  and  joined  with  the  worshippers.  No 
act  or  word  of  His  is  recorded  which  tends 
in  the  least  towards  a  depreciation  of  the 
Temple  service,  which  was  above  all  else  a 
service  of  worship.  This  seiwice  of  worship 
we  find  referred  to  by  all  the  Fathers  of  the 
Church  (Justin.  Apol.  ii.  98 ;  Chrys.  de 
Sacerdot.  vi.  c.  4,  &c.),  and  we  of  the  English 
Church  join  in  the  chorus  of  saints  when 
we  sing,  "  We  praise  Thee,  we  worship 
Thee,"  after  we  have  participated  in  the 
highest  act  of  worship. 

II.  The  word  is  used  iu  a  lower  sense. 
Besides  the  usual  application  of  this  term  to 
the  supreme  homage  and  devotion  due  only 
to  the  Divine  Being,  it  is  occasionally  used 
in  the  Bible  and  Prayer  Book  to  denote 
honour,  respect,  and  reverence  given  to 
men.  Thus,  in  the  84th  Psalm,  it  is  said 
that  "  the  Lord  will  give  grace  and  worship 
(favour  and  dignity)  to  them  that  live  a 
godly  life."  In  the  Order  of  Matrimony  in 
the  English  Prayer  Book,  the  husband 
promises  to  worship  his  wife,  that  is,  to 
render  to  her  all  that  respect  and  honom'  to 
which  she  is  entitled  by  the  command  of 
God,  and  the  station  she  holds. 

Hooker  explains  this  from  the  fact,  that 


784 


XEEOPHAGIA 


in  heathen  tunes  men  had  two  wives,  the 
one  called  the  primary  or  lawful  wife,  the 
■other  the  half  wife,  or  concubine  (Kccles. 
Pol.  v.,  Ixxii.  8).  I5y  the  old  Roman  law, 
this  was  the  difference  between  a  wife  and 
a  concubine:  that  the  husband  before 
marriage  promised  that  he  designed  to  pro- 
mote the  woman  he  was  married  to,  to  the 
honour  of  materfamilias,  or  mistress  of  the 
family. 

"The  first  right  accruing  to  the  wife  by 
marriage,  is  honour;  and,  therefore,  the 
man  says,  '  with  my  body  I  thee  worship  ; ' 
that  is,  '  with  my  body  I  thee  honour : ' 
for  so  the  word  signifies  in  this  place ;  and 
so  Mr.  Selden,  and  before  him  Martin 
Bucer,  who  Uved  at  the  time  when  our 
liturgy  was  compiled,  have  translated  it. 
The  design  of  it  is  to  express  that  the 
woman,  by  virtue  of  this  maniage,  has  a 
share  in  all  the  titles  and  honours  which  are 
due,  or  belong  to,  the  person  of  her  husband. 
It  is  true  the  modem  sense  of  the  word  is 
somewhat  different:  for  which  reason,  I 
find,  that  at  the  review  of  our  liturgy,  after 
the  restoration  of  King  Charles  II.,  'wor- 
ship' was  promised  to  be  changed  for 
'honour.'  How  the  alteration  came  to  be 
omitted  I  cannot  discover;  but  so  long  as 
the  old  word  is  explained  in  the  sense  that 
I  have  given  of  it,  one  would  thmk  no 
objection  could  he  urged  against  using  it." — 
Wheatly. 


XEEOPHAGIA  (Sripo<f)ayla),  from  ^.jpdr, 
■dry,  and  (j>ayeiv,  to  eat.  Fast  days  in  the 
early  Christian  Church.  They  are  defined 
by  Epiphanius  to  he  days  when  bread  and 
salt  only  were  used,  and  water  only  allowed 
in  the  evening  (^Compend.  Doctr.  Oath.). 
TertuUian  refers  to  this  fast,  connecting 
"lavacri  abstinentiam "  with  the  Xero- 
phagia  {Adv.  Psych,  i.  14,  15).  This  fast 
was  kept  dming  the  six  days  of  the  Holy 
Week  for  devotion,  but  was  not  obligatory 
(See  Fasting).  The  50th  canon  of  the 
jOouncil  of  Laodicea  forbids  the  remission  of 
fasting  on  the  fifth  day  of  the  Holy  Week, 
"fasting  being  continued  throughout  Lent, 
^po(f>ayovvTts ; "  on  which  Balsamon  re- 
marks, "  not  however  on  the  Sabbaths  and 
Sundays  in  Lent,  for  on  these  days  we  are 
not  compelled  to  ^rjpofj^aydp,  as  we  are  on 
the  other  days  of  the  fast"  (Can.  Ap.  69). 
Fish  at  first  was  only  permissible,  but 
others  added  fowl  to  the  food  allowed  (Soc. 
E.E.  V.  22). 


ZWINGLIANS 


Y. 

YEAR,  ECCLESIASTICAL  (See  Ad- 
vent, Calendar,  and  Feasts'). 

YORK,  Use  of  (See  Use). 

YULE.  An  Old  Enghsli  word  signifying 
probably  "  noise " ;  hence  loud  sound  of 
mirth  and  so  on.  Compare  the  Old  English 
gylan,  to  make  meriy,  and  the  German 
"jolen,"  "jodeln,"  to  sing  in  a  high- 
pitched  voice.  The  yule  of  August  anciently 
signified  Lammas;  but  the  word  is  now 
used  to  denote  the  festival  of  Christmas 
only.  The  yule  log  in  Yorkshire  corre-' 
sponding  to  the  ashen  faggot  in  Devonshire 
is  still  in  many  places  burnt  on  Christmas- 
eve,  or  Yule  Time.  See  Johnson  in  voc, 
and  Skeat's  Etymol.  Diet. 


ZEALOTS.  A  sect  of  the  Jews,  so 
called  from  their  pretended  great  zeal  for 
Gud's  law,  and  the  honour  of  religion. 
Simon  the  Apostle,  from  his  surname  Zelotes 
(St.  Luke  vi.  15),  which  is  equivalent  to  tlie 
Chaldaic  Kavavaios  of  SS.  Matt,  and  Mark, 
is  supposed  to  have  originally  belonged  to 
this  sect.  They  were  a  branch  of  the  Pha- 
risees, though  some  account  them  a  distinct 
sect  (See  Pharisees). 

The  Zealots  were  a  most  violent  and 
ungovernable  set  of  fanatics,  who  on  pre- 
tence of  asserting  the  honour  of  God's  laws, 
and  the  strictness  and  purity  of  religion, 
assumed  a  liberty  of  questioning  notorious 
offenders,  ivithout  staying  for  the  ordi- 
nary formalities  of  law :  and  even  when 
they  thought  fit,  they  executed  capital 
punishments  upon  them  with  their  own 
hands. 

Tlie  fall  of  Jerusalem  was  accelerated  by 
these  fanatics,  as  may  be  seen  in  Josephus' 
history. — B.  Jud.  iv.  c.  iii.  9,  13,  14;  vii. 
viii.  c.  1  (See  Jost,  Oeschichte  des  Juden- 
thums  und  seiner  Sekten). 

ZWINGLIANS.  The  disciples  of  the 
Reformer  Ulric  Zwingli,  a  Canon  of  Zurich 
A.D.  1516-1531.  It  was  long  and  vehe- 
mently disputed  between  the  followers  of 
Luther  and  Zwingli  which  of  the  two 
masters  was  entitled  to  the  honour  of 
having  led  the  way  to  the  Reformation. 
The  fact  appears  to  be  that  Zwingli  was 
the  first  to  detect  the  corruption  °of  the 
Roman  Church,  but  the  circumstances  in 
which  he  was  placed  did  not  so  soon 
involve  him  id  open  conflict  with  the 
hierarchy ;  and  although  he  diverged  from 


ZWINGLIAVS 

the  Eomaii  Chuicli  in  his  views  upon  doc- 
trine farther  than  Luther,  he  did  not  act 
with  so  much  daring,  nor  in  so  wide  a 
sphere.  Moreover  he  died  young,  and 
lienco,  although  he  was  a  man  of  more 
learning  and  judgment  than  Luther,  he 
never  acquired  such  a  wide  reputation.  His 
disagreement  -with  Luther  on  the  Ileal 
Presence  made  a  comjilete  separation  be- 
tvreen  them.  Luther  held  that,  together 
with  the  bread  and  wine,  the  body  and  blood 
of  Christ  were  really  present  in  the  Eucharist. 
Zwingli  held,  that  the  bread  and  wine  were 
only  signs  and  symbols  of  the  absent  body 
and  blood  of  Christ ;  so  that  the  Eucharist 
was  merely  a  pious  and  solemn  ceremony, 
to  bring  it  to  the  remembrance  of  the 
faithful.  The  opinions  of  Zwingli  were 
adopted  in  Switzerland,  and  several  neigh- 
bouring countries.  They  gave  rise  to  the 
most  violent  animosities  between  their  fa- 


ZWINGLIANS 


785 


vom'ers  and  the  disciples  of  Luther.  Fre- 
quent advances  to  peace  were  made  by  the 
Zwiuglians;  Luther  uniformly  rejected 
them  with  sternness.  He  declared  an 
union  to  be  impossible;  he  called  the 
Zwinglians  "  ministers  of  Satan."  When 
they  entreated  him  to  consider  them  as 
brothers,  "  What  fraternity,"  he  exclaimed, 
"  do  you  ask  with  me,  if  you  persist  in  your 
belief?"  On  one  occasion,  the  ingenuity  of 
Bucer  enabled  him  to  frame  a  creed,  which 
each  party,  construing  the  words  in  his  own 
sense,  might  sign.  This  effected  a  tempo- 
rary truce ;  but  the  division  soon  broke 
out  with  iresh  animosity.  "  Happy,"  ex- 
claimed Luther,  "is  the  man  who  has  not 
be«n  of  the  counsel  of  the  Sacramentarians ; 
who  has  not  walked  in  the  ways  of  the 
Zwinglians"  (Schroeckh's  Kirchengesch.  i. 
103;  Stubbs'  Mosheim,  ii.  394,  402-406). 


APPENDIX. 


{See  Maries,  St.,  Gospel.) 


A  note  in  the  Revised  Version  of  tlie 
New  Testament  at  the  last  twelve  verses  of 
this  gospel,  which  record  tlie  Ascension,  did 
all  it  could  to  expel  them  short  of  actual 
omission,  and  so  revived  an  old  controversy 
with  the  effect  of  producing  some  new  and 
very  striking  evidence  in  favour  of  the 
received  text  and  Authorised  Version.  The 
note  is  this : 

"The  two  oldest  Greek  MSS.  and  some 
other  authorities  omit  from  v.  9  to  the  end. 
Some  others  have  a  different  ending  to  the 
gospel " ;  and  the  Eevisers  put  a  wide  hreak 
in  their  text  hefore  v.  9.  A  considerahle 
book  in  vindication  of  the  verses  had  been 
published  some  years  before  by  Dean 
Burgon,  to  which  he  says  in  his  later  book, 
"  The  Revision  Eevised,"  that  no  answer  has 
ever  been  attempted.  Dr.  Scrivener,  the 
greatest  of  modern  textual  critics  by  general 
consent,  also  defends  them  in  all  the  edi- 
tions of  his  "  Introduction  to  the  Criticism 
of  the  New  Testament,"  both  before 
and  since  the  publication  of  the  Eevised 
Version  and  Dr.  Hort's  "Introduction  to 
the  Greek  Testament,"  which  contains  28 
close  pages  against  the  verses.  Canon  Cook, 
the  editor  of  the  "  Speaker's  Commentary," 
in  his  booki  on  "  the  Eevised  Version  of  the 
first  three  Gospels,"  has  produced  some  new 
historical  reasons  of  overwhelming  weight, 
as  his  facts  are  not  disputed,  against  the 
"  two  oldest  MSS."  on  which  Dr.  Hort  founds 
most  of  his  expulsions  of  received  texts,  and 
sometimes  on  one  of  them  against  the  other. 
A  summary  of  the  latest  arguments  was 
given  in  the  "  Quarterly  Eeview,"  vol.  154, 
by  a  vTriter  whose  own  name  would  have 
added  weight  to  it,  and  who  added  a  further 
discovery  of  his  own  which  strongly  con- 
firms Canon  Cook's  conclusion  about  the 
independent  value  of  the  two  MSS. 

They  are  the  Vatican  (B)  and  the  Sinaitic, 
which  is  denoted  by  X,  A  having  been  long 
appropriated  to  the  rather  later  Alexandrian 
MS.,  which  was  more  than  any  other  the 


basis  of  the  textus  reccptus,  the  parent  of  the 
A.  V.     All  parties  agree  that  N  and  B  were 
written  between  330  and  340  a.d.  ;  and  of 
course  they  were  copied  from  either  one  or 
more  then   existing  copies.     Consequently, 
though  they  are  now  the  oldest  surviving 
MSS.  of  the  whole  or  most  of  the  N.  T.,  the 
quotation  of  any  psissage  as  genuine  by  an 
earlier  writer  of  authority,  or  the  general  use 
of  it  in  lectionaries  not  much  later,  is  both 
earlier  and  better  evidence  than  its  omission 
in  these    two    MSS.     and   its  mere   non- 
quotation  by  any  writer  who  was  not  want- 
ing a  Scriptural  authority  for  (in  this  case) 
the  Ascension  is  nothing  against  it.  Dr.  Hort 
admits  that  Irenasus  used  this  passage  in  the 
2nd  century,  "  and  possibly  Justin "  also ; 
and  it  was  actually  one  of  the  lessons  for 
Ascension-day  in  the  early  Greek  lection- 
aries.    All  that  however  goes  for  nothing 
with  Dr.  Hort  against  what  he  calls  "  the 
unique  criterion  supplied  by  the  independent 
attestations  of  k  and  B,"  and  he  is  quite  sure 
that  they  represent  independent  streams  of 
still  earlier  testimonj'.     But  no  reply  worth 
notice,  and  none  by  IDr.  Hort  himself  or  any 
of  his  colleagues,   has  been  made  to  the 
conclusion    of   the   four  writers  we    have 
mentioned,  that  there  is  nothing  worthy  to 
be  called  evidence  of  any  such  independent 
representation,  even  if  there  were  none  the 
other  way ;  nor  a  single  scrap  of  history  or 
allusion    by  anybody   to   that    imaginary 
"  Syrian  recension "  or  revised  version  by 
some  imperfectly  informed  conclave  at  some 
later  period,  to  which  Dr.  Hort  attributes  the 
manufacture  of   the  received  Greek  text. 
Canon  Cook  introduces  us  more  fully  than 
any  one  before  to  the  real  nature  of  the 
undoubted  recension  by  Eusebius  under  the 
order  of  Constantine,  of  which  there  can 
henceforth  be  no  reasonable  doubt  that  X 
and  B  are  only  different  copies  made  by  two 
scribes,  and  as  to  this  passage  by  one,  at  the 
same  time  and  place,  from  such  previous  MS. 
or  MSS.  as  were  set  before  them.   The  story 


APPENDIX. 


787 


as  made  out  by  Canon  Cook  and  his  reviewer 
is  a  very  striking  case  of  circumstantial 
evidence — not  tlieory  from  what  Dr.  Hort 
calls  internal  evidence,  which  resolves  itself 
into  his  own  opinion  at  every  point. 

Eusebius  himself  records  that  Constantino 
had  desired  him  to  get  fifty  copies  of  the 
Bible  transcribed  as  quickly  as  possible  for 
the  public  use  of  the  great  number  of  people 
who  had  then  joined  the  Church.  They 
were  to  be  written  by  expert  scribes,  and  the 
emperor  ordered  the  treasurer  of  the  province 
to  supply  all  the  materials,  and  Eusebius 
was  authorised  to  employ  two  public  car- 
riages. He  adds  that  "the  work  followed 
immediately  on  the  emperor's  word;"  and 
gives  a  particular  description  of  what  we  may 
call  the  typography  of  the  books  when 
done,  i.e.  that  they  were  written  rpia-aa  koI 
TeTpacra-a :  which  might  mean  several  things, 
but  unquestionably  agrees  with  the  fact 
that  N  and  B  are  written  throughout  in  pages 
of  four  and  three  columns  respectively. 
Facsimiles  are  given  by  both  Burgon  and 
Scrivener.  Eusebius  also  says  that  the  parch- 
ment or  vellum  was  of  the  very  best ;  which 
is  against  the  case  with  those  two  MSS.  It 
seeuis  to  have  been  the  skin  of  antelopes. 
Both  of  them  are  remarkable  for  the  beautj' 
of  the  writing.  But  they  appear  to  corre- 
spond no  less  to  what  might  be  expected 
from  the  emperor's  order  for  the  greatest 
expedition.  Eor,  besides  the  multitude  of 
questionable  omissions,  it  now  turns  out, 
though  the  early  editors  of  the  Vatican  had 
naturally  corrected  that  transjjarent  error, 
IhatB  abounds  in  careless  repetitions  of  words 
and  clauses ;  and  also  the  less  manifest  one 
of  dropping  whole  lines  or  clauses,  so  as  to 
make  nonsense,  from  the  writer's  eye  having 
taken  a  bad  shot — a  risk  to  which  all  copiers 
are  liable ;  and  it  is  fortunate  when  their  mis- 
take makes  nonsense,  because  it  then  reveals 
itself.  N  also  appears  to  have  been  done  so 
carelessly  that  the  scribe  of  B  was  employed 
to  rewrite  several  sheets  of  it — and  this  one 
for  another  reason.  Dr.  Hort  admits  that 
the  scribe  whom  we  may  call  B  wrote  six 
leaves  of  X ;  and  from  certain  indications 
they  were  what  printers  call  "cancels"  or 
substitutes  for  others  taken  out ;  and  it  is 
admitted  that  the  sheet  containing  the  last 
chapter  of  St.  Mark  is  one  of  them.  So  there 
is  an  end  of  the  theory  of  independence  of 
K  and  B  as  to  this  passage,  and  of  their 
representing  different  streams  of  tradition 
or  tran.smission,  for  which  there  is  not  a 
word  of  evidence.  And  for  all  we  know, 
{<  was  at  first  \vritten  with  these  very 
verses,  as  we  shall  see  presently.  Tisohen- 
dorf  speaks  of  the  inagna  vitiositas  of  both 
K  and  B,  though  he  was  himself  the 
discoverer  of  t?  in  one  of  the  monasteries 
of  Sinai ;  and  they  are  specially  remarkable 


for  their  great  multitude  of  omissions  com- 
pared with  all  other  MSS.  and  versions, 
except  one  or  two  which  manifestly  followed 
them,  especially  the  one  called  L.  Dr. 
Hort,  whose  ingenuity  in  defending  his  own 
multitude  of  omissions  is  equal  to  nearly 
every  difliculty,  invented  a  theory  of  what 
he  called  "  conflation,"  which  always  acts  in 
favour  of  omission,  and  is  almost  ipso  facto 
condemned  thereby.  It  is  too  complicated 
to  explain  here,  and  is  logically  blown  to 
pieces  by  Burgon,  Cook,  and  Scrivener, 
though  some  much  smaller  critics  think  it 
very  convincing,  and  the  majority  of  the 
Kevisers  did  so  too ;  or,  more  probably,  could 
not  answer  him  from  want  of  knowledge, 
and  voted  down  Dr.  Scrivener,  who  was 
very  likely  a  less  nimble  advocate  though  an 
older  and  a  far  more  cautious  judge.  Now 
let  us  see  how  the  B  scribe  dealt  with  these 
final  verses  of  St.  Mark  in  the  "  two  inde- 
pendent MSS."  which  his  sole  hand  has  left 
us.     And  first  of  B  itself. 

In  no  other  place  in  the  whole  volume 
of  both  Testaments  is  there  an  entire  blank 
column  left  between  one  book  and  the  next. 
But  between  St.  Mark  and  St.  Luke  there  is, 
and  not  only  it  whole  column,  but  nearly 
twelve  lines  over ;  more  than  enough  to  leave 
a  wide  break  to  mark  the  end  of  the  book,  and 
an  ornamental  finial  besides.  The  columns 
of  B  have  forty-two  lines  of  sixteen  to 
eighteen  letters,  while  S  has  forty-eight  of 
generally  twelve.  Until  the  Q.  Beviewer 
pointed  out  what  comes  next,  it  was  a 
fm'ther  puzzle  that  N  has  not  a  whole 
blanlv  column  in  the  same  place,  but  has 
just  seven  words  at  the  top  of  it ;  and  various 
solutions  were  guessed  at.  But  he  found  a 
very  simple  one  in  the  fact  that  the  scribe, 
apparently  not  having  given  satisfaction  by 
Ms  feat  in  B,  spread  his  last  full  column 
out  wider,  in  re-writing  N,  giving  it 
considerably  fewer  letters  and  words  than 
the  average  in  that  neighbourhood,  and  so 
managed  to  make  a  pretence  of  occupying 
another  column.  If  one  such  abnormally 
vacant  column  could  be  explained  away 
as  an  accident,  it  is  quite  impossible  that 
two  can  be  accidental  in  the  very  same 
place,  and  no  other  in  the  two  MSS. ;  and 
now  tins  proved  contrivance  to  prevent  the 
appearance  of  a  second  vacancy  makes  the 
whole  transaction  a  most  suspicious  com- 
bination instead  of  two  independent  testi- 
monies. 

What  then  was  it  done  for,  and  what 
does  it  prove?  First  it  proves  that  the 
scribe  knew  very  well  that  St.  Mark's  gospel 
as  generally  received  did  not  end  with 
ecjiofiovvTo  yap,  and  evidently  expected  to 
have  to  write  in  the  other  twelve  verses 
afterwards.  Indeed  Dr.  Hort  himself 
admits  that   there  must  have  been  some 


788 


APPENDIX. 


other  ending  beyond  that,  and  also  that 
another  entirely  difl'erent  "short  oonclu- 
siunj"  as  he  calls  it,  which  appears  in  the 
aforesaid  MS.  L,  is  manifestly  spurious. 
Whether  the  twelve  versos  were  erased,  or 
absent  from  some  other  cause,  in  the  copy 
which  Busebius  had  given  to  the  scribe,  the 
omission  was  much  too  large  to  escape  his 
notice,  as  a  few  letters  or  words  here  and 
there  might.  It  is  very  suspicious  that  he 
is  said,  and  not  denied,  to  have  been  the  first 
person  who  advocated  it,  whether  it  first 
came  from  design  or  from  a  casual  loss  of  one 
leaf  in  some  older  MS.  Dr.  Hort  admits 
there  must  have  been  a  loss  of  something  : 
in  other  words,  that  both  his  favourite 
MSS.  are  wrong.  Then  why  was  not  the 
omission  of  these  verses  ?  And  then  comes 
in  the  awkward  fact  that  Eusebius  was 
suspected  and  accused  of  Arianism,  and  that 
the  Arians  had  been  received  into  favour 
by  Constantine  about  the  very  time  that 
this  editicu  of  the  fifty  copies  was  ordered 
and  made.  It  may  well  be  called  provi- 
dential that  two  of  them  have  sm-vived  to 
tell  this  tale  of  Eusebiau  contrivance  for 
excluduig  one  of  the  two  gospel  records  of 
the  Ascension.  And  the  other  by  an  equally 
suspicious  coincidence,  is  dropped  by  N  out  of 
St.  Luke  xxii.  51,  though  B  is  innocent  of 
that ;  and  there  Dr.  Hort  throws  his  most 
favomite  MS.  over,  and  jjersuaded  the  Re- 
visers to  depreciate  that  text  also  by  a  note. 


It  must  not  be  supposed  however  that 
X  and  B  do  not  often  differ :  which  proves 
either  great  carelessness  and  vitiositas,  or 
else,  what  is  known  otherwise,  that  MSS. 
had  begun  to  diverge  considerably,  and 
therefore  to  abound  in  errors,  long  before 
the  4th  century.  And  therefore  it  by  no 
raeans  follows  that  copies  made  in  that 
age  are  more  accurate  than  later  ones, 
which  may  have  been  derived  from  better 
originals,  or  more  carefully  collated.  This 
does  not  even  profess  to  be  a  summary  of 
all  that  has  been  written  on  this  large 
omission  from  the  gospel ;  but  as  the  case 
for  it  now  avowedly  depends  on  these  two 
MSS.,  against  which  the  latest  discoveries 
seem  decisive  in  this  place  at  any  rate, 
and  as  to  their  independence,  everywhere, 
we  have  not  thought  it  necessary  to  discuss 
the  case  as  it  stood  before.  The  wonder  is 
that,  with  all  the  influence  of  Constantine 
and  the  advantage  of  his  fifty  magnificent 
copies,  Eusebius  could  get  practically  no 
concurrence  from  later  editors  in  his  omis- 
sions; for  there  is  an  enonnous  prepon- 
derance against  them.  They  evidently  knew 
the  "  magna  scripturm  vitiositas  "  of  these 
two,  and  probably  of  aU  those  fifty  copies. 
Sec  Burgon's  Last  Twelve  Verses  of  St. 
Mark,  and  The  Revision  Mevised,  and 
Scrivener's  Introduction  to  the  Criticism  of 
the  N.  T.,  3rd  edition,  and  Salmon's  Intro- 
diKtion  to  the  N.  T.,  2nd  ed.     [G-.] 


Tflli  Exto. 


tOKDOK:    I'RINIED  at    WaLIAJl  CLOlVia  ANU   bu.NS,  LIMITED,  SIAMFOKD  StKEEt 
AM)  CUAIUXG  CROSS.